DI–1
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00F–08
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following page.
Titles inside
are titles of pages in
this manual with the page number indicated
in the bottom portion. See the indicated
pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
2
Customer Problem Analysis P. DI–2
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 P. DI–3
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tool, inspect DLC3 P. DI–3
3
Check DTC and Freezed Frame Data (Precheck)
Record or Print DTC and Freezed Frame Data P. DI–3
4
Clear DTC and Freezed Frame Data P. DI–3
5
Visual Inspection
6
Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis P. DI–3
7
Problem Symptom Confirmation
If the engine does not start perform steps 10 and 12 first
Malfunction
occurs.
9
10
DTC Check P. DI–3
Normal
Basic Inspection P. DI–3
12
14
8
Malfunction code.
11
DTC Chart P. DI–16
Problem Symptoms Table P. DI–28
Parts Inspection
15
Malfunction does not occur.
Symptom Simulation P. IN–21
13
Circuit Inspection P. DI–29
Check for Intermittent Problems P. DI–3
Identification of Problem
16
Adjustment, Repair
17
Confirmation Test
End
Author:
Date:
236
DI–2
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00G–05
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
Model and Model
Year
Driver’s Name
Frame No.
Data Vehicle
Brought in
Engine Model
License No.
Odometer Reading
Problem Symptoms
Customer’s Name
Engine does
not Start
Engine does not crank
Difficult to
Start
Engine cranks slowly
Other
Poor Idling
Incorrect first idle
Idling rpm is abnormal
Rough idling
Other
Poor
Driveaability
Hesitation
Knocking
Engine Stall
Soon after starting
After accelerator pedal depressed
After accelerator pedal released
During A/C operation
Shifting from N to D
Other
km
miles
No initial combustion
Back fire
Other
No complete combustion
High (
rpm)
Low (
Muffler explosion (after–fire)
rpm)
Surging
Others
Datas Problem
Occurred
Constant
Other
Condition When
Problem Occurs
Problem Frequency
Sometimes (
times per
day/month)
Weather
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
Outdoor
Temperature
Hot
Warm
Cool
Cold (approx.
Place
Highway
Rough road
Engine Temperature
Engine Operation
Cold
Suburbs
Other
Warming up
Inner city
After warming up
Just after starting (
Starting
Driving
Constant speed
A/C switch ON/OFF
Other
Condition of MIL
Normal Mode
(Precheck)
Once only
Various/Other
°F/
°C)
Uphill
Downhill
Any temperature
min.)
Idling
Acceleration
Other
Racing
Deceleration
Remains on
Sometimes light up
Does not light up
Normal
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freezed frame data (
)
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freezed frame data (
)
)
DTC Inspection
Check Mode
Normal
Author:
)
Date:
237
DI–3
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00H–08
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure
is that you connect to the vehicle the OBD II scan
tool complying with SAE J1978 or TOYOTA hand–
held tester, and read off various data output from
the vehicle’s ECM.
FI0534
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester
DLC3
S05331
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s on–
board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the emission control
system / components or in the powertrain control
components which affect vehicle emissions, or a
malfunction in the computer. In addition to the MIL
lighting up when a malfunction is detected, the applicable Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) prescribed
by SAE J2012 are recorded in the ECM memory.
(See page DI–16)
If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3 consecutive trips, the
MIL goes off automarially but the DTCs remain recorded in the
ECM memory.
To check the DTCs, connect the OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to Data Link Connector
3 (DLC3) on the vehicle. The OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester also enables you to
erase the DTCs and check freezed frame data and
various forms of engine data (For operating instructions, see the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book.)
DTCs include SAE controlled codes and manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled codes must
be set as prescribed by the SAE, while manufacturer controlled codes can be set freely by the
manufacturer within the prescribed limits. (See DTC
chart on page DI–16)
Author:
Date:
238
DI–4
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode
during normal vehicle use. It also has a check mode
for technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms
and troubleshoot. Most DTCs use 2 trip detection
logic* to prevent erroneous detection, and ensure
thorough malfunction detection. By switching the
ECM to check mode when troubleshooting, the
technician can cause the MIL to light up for a malfunction that is only detected once or momentarily.
(TOYOTA hand–held tester only)
(See page DI–3)
*2 trip detection logic: When a malfunction is first
detected, the malfunction is temporarily stored in
the ECM memory.(1st trip)
If the same malfunction is detected again during the second
drive test, this second detection causes the MIL to light up.(2nd
trip) (However, the IG switch must be turned OFF between the
1st trip and the 2nd trip.)
Freeze frame data:
Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when a misfire (DTCs P0300 ∼ P0304) or fuel trim
malfunction (DTCs P0171, P0172) or other malfunction (first malfunction only), is detected.
Because freeze frame data records the engine
conditions (fuel system, calculated load, engine
coolant temperature, fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, etc.) when the malfunction is detected,
when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich,
etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Priorities for troubleshooting:
If troubleshooting priorities for multiple DTCs are given in the
applicable DTC chart, these should be followed.
If no instructions are given troubleshoot DTCs according to the
following priorities.
(1) DTCs other than fuel trim malfunction (DTCs
P0171, P0172), EGR (DTCs P0401, P0402), and
misfire (DTCs P0300 ∼ P0304).
(2) Fuel trim malfunction (DTCs P0171, P0172), and
EGR (DTCs P0401, P0402).
(3) Misfire (DTCs P0300 ∼ P0304).
Author:
Date:
239
DI–5
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check the DLC3
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141–2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE
J1962 and matches the ISO 9141–2 format.
N09214
Terminal No.
Connection / Voltage or Resistance
Condition
7
Bus Line / Pulse generation
During transmission
4
Chassis Ground ↔ Body Ground /1 Ω or less
Always
5
Signal Ground ↔ Body Ground /1 Ω or less
Always
16
Battery Positive ↔ Body Ground /9 ∼ 14 V
Always
HINT:
If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE”
when you have connected the cable of the OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch
ON and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle side or tool side.
If communication is normal when the tool is connected to
another vehicle, inspect DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in the
tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in the
tool’s instruction manual.
2.
(a)
S05347
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (Normal Mode)
Check the MIL.
(1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned
ON and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter
(See page BE–2).
(2) When the engine started, the MIL should go off. If
the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system has detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
(b) Check the DTC.
NOTICE:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only: When the diagnosis system is switched from normal mode to check mode, it
erases all DTCs and freezed frame data recorded in normal
mode. So before switching modes, always check the DTCs
and freezed frame data, and note them down.
(1) Prepare the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Author:
Date:
240
DI–6
DIAGNOSTICS
(2)
(3)
(4)
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester to DLC3 under the instrument panel lower pad.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester switch ON.
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to check the DTCs and freezed frame data
and note them down. (For operating instructions,
see the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book.)
See page DI–3 to confirm the details of the DTCs.
(5)
NOTICE:
When simulating symptoms with an OBD II scan tool
(excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) to check the
DTCs, use normal mode. For code on the DTC chart
subject to ”2 trip detection logic”, perform the following either action.
Turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is
simulated the first time. Then repeat the simulation
process again. When the problem has been simulated
twice, the MIL lights up and the DTCs are recorded in
the ECM.
Check the 1st trip DTC using Mode 7 (Continuous Test
Results) for SAE J1979.
(c) Clear the DTC.
The DTCs and freezed frame data will be erased by either
action.
(1) Operating the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase the
codes. (See the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book
for operating instructions.)
(2) Disconnecting the battery terminals or EFI fuse.
NOTICE:
If the TOYOTA hand–held tester switches the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice–versa, or if the ignition
switch is turned from ON to ACC or OFF during check
mode, the DTCs and freezed frame data will be erased.
Author:
Date:
241
DI–7
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
3.
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (Check Mode)
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only:
Compared to the normal mode, the check mode has an increased sensitivity to detect malfunctions.
Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are detected in
the normal mode can also be detected in the check mode.
(a) Check the DTC.
(1) Initial conditions
Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
Throttle valve fully closed
Transmission in P or N position
Air conditioning switched OFF
(2) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(3) Prepare the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
(4) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC3 under the instrument panel lower pad.
(5) Turn the ignition switch ON and switch the TOYOTA
hand–held tester ON.
(6)
Flashing
ON
OFF
0.13 Second
FI3605
Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester normal mode
to check mode. (Check that the MIL flashes.)
NOTICE:
If the TOYOTA hand–held tester switches the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice–versa, or if the ignition switch is turned from ON to ACC or LOCK during check
mode, the DTCs and freezed frame data will be erased.
(7) Start the engine. (The MIL goes out after the engine
start.)
(8) Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by the customer.
NOTICE:
Leave the ignition switch ON until you have checked the
DTC, etc.
(9) After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
TOYOTA hand–held tester diagnosis selector to
check the DTCs and freezed frame data, etc.
HINT:
Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF. Turning the ignition
switch OFF switches the diagnosis system from check mode to
normal mode. So all DTCs, etc. are erased.
(10) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
Author:
Date:
242
DI–8
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
4.
FAIL–SAFE CHART
If any of the following codes is recorded, the ECM enters fail–safe mode.
DTC No.
Fail–Safe Operation
Fail–Safe Deactivation Conditions
P0105
Ignition timing fixed at 5° BTDC
Returned to normal condition
P0110
Intake air temperature is fixed at 20°C (68°F)
Returned to normal condition
P0115
Engine coolant temperature is fixed at 80°(176°F)
Returned to normal condition
P0120
VTA is fixed at 0°
The following condition must be repeated at least 2 times
consecutively
VTA 0.1 V and 0.95 V
P0135
P0141
The heater circuit in witch an abnormality is detected is
turned off
Ignition switch OFF
P0325
Max. timing retardation
Ignition switch OFF
P0336
Fuel cut
Returned to normal condition
P1135
The heater circuit in which an abnormality is detected is
turned off
Ignition switch OFF
P1300
P1310
Fuel cut
IGF signal is detected for 2 consecutive ignitions
5.
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER only:
By putting the vehicle’s ECM in check mode, 1 trip detection logic is possible instead of 2 trip detection logic
and sensitivity to detect open circuits is increased. This makes it easier to detect intermittent problems.
(1) Clear the DTC (See page DI–3).
(2) Set the check mode (See page DI–3).
(3) Perform a simulation test (See page IN–21).
(4) Check the connector and terminal (See page IN–31).
(5) Handle the connector (See page IN–31).
6.
BASIC INSPECTION
When the malfunction code is not confirmed in the DTC check, troubleshooting should be performed in the
order for all possible circuits to be considered as the causes of the problems. In many cases, by carrying
out the basic engine check shown in the following flow chart, the location causing the problem can be found
quickly and efficiently. Therefore, use of this check is essential in engine troubleshooting.
1
Is battery positive voltage 11 V or more when engine is stopped?
NO
Charge or replace battery.
YES
Author:
Date:
243
DI–9
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Is engine cranked?
NO
Proceed to page ST–2 and continue to
troubleshoot.
NO
Go to step 7.
YES
3
Does engine start?
YES
4
Check air filter.
PREPARATION:
Remove the air filter.
CHECK:
Visually check that the air filter is not dirty or excessive oily.
HINT:
If necessary, clean the filter with compressed air. First blow from
inside thoroughly, then blow from outside of the filter.
Outside
Inside
P00495
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
244
DI–10
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check idle speed.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Switch off all the accessories.
(c) Switch off the air conditioning.
(d) Shift the transmission into the N position.
(e) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 on the vehicle.
CHECK:
Use the CURRENT DATA to check the idle speed.
OK:
Idle speed: 650 ∼ 750 rpm
NG
Proceed to problem symptoms table on
page DI–28.
OK
Author:
Date:
245
DI–11
DIAGNOSTICS
6
TE1
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check ignition timing.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Shift the transmission into the N position.
(c) Keep the engine speed at idle.
(d) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(e) Using a timing light, connect the tester to the No.1 high–
tension cord.
CHECK:
Check the ignition timing.
OK:
Ignition timing: 10° BTDC at idle
E1
SST
DLC1
NG
A07370
S05309
–
A07664
Proceed to page IG–1 and continue to troubleshoot.
OK
Proceed to problem symptoms table on page
DI–28.
Author:
Date:
246
DI–12
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check fuel pressure.
Fuel Inlet Hose
S05327
PREPARATION:
(a) Be sure that enough fuel is in the tank.
(b) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and push TOYOTA hand–held
tester main switch ON.
(d) Use the ACTIVE TEST mode to operate the fuel pump.
(e) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
(f)
If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, connect the
positive (+) and negative (–) leads from the battery to the
fuel pump connector (See page SF–6).
CHECK:
Check for fuel pressure in the fuel inlet hose when it is pinched
off.
HINT:
At this time, you will hear a fuel flowing noise.
NG
Proceed to page SF–6 and continue to troubleshoot.
OK
Author:
Date:
247
DI–13
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for spark.
A00359
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the high–tension cord from the spark plug.
(b) Remove the spark plug.
(c) Install the spark plug to the high–tension cord.
(d) Disconnect the injector connector.
(e) Ground the spark plug.
CHECK:
Check if spark occurs while the engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
To prevent excess fuel being injected from the injectors
during this test, don’t crank the engine for more than 5 ∼ 10
seconds at a time.
NG
Proceed to page IG–1 and continue to troubleshoot.
OK
Proceed to problem symptoms table on page
DI–28.
Author:
Date:
248
DI–14
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
7.
ENGINE OPERATING CONDITION
NOTICE:
The values given below for ”Normal Condition” are representative values, so a vehicle may still be
normal even if its value varies from those listed here. So do not decide whether a part is faulty or
not solely according to the ”Normal Condition” here.
(a) CARB mandated signals.
TOYOTA hand–held tester display
Measurement Item
Normal Condition*1
FUEL SYS #1
Fuel System Bank 1
OPEN: Air–fuel ratio feedback stopped
CLOSED: Air–fuel ratio feedback operating
Idling after warming up: CLOSED
CALC LOAD
Calculator Load:
Current intake air volume as a proportion of max.
intake air volume
Idling: 19.7 ∼ 50.4 %
Racing without load (2,500rpm): 16.8 ∼ 47.4 %
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor Value
After warming up: 80 ∼ 95°C (176 ∼ 203°F)
COOLANT TEMP.
SHORT FT #1
Short–term Fuel Trim Bank 1
0 ± 20 %
LONG FT #1
Long–term Fuel Trim Bank 1
0 ± 20 %
ENGINE SPD
Engine Speed
Idling: 650 ∼ 750 rpm
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle Speed
Vehicle Stopped: 0 km/h (0 mph)
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition Advance:
Ignition Timing of Cylinder No. 1
Idling: BTDC 0 ∼ 10°
Intake Air Temp. Sensor Value
Equivalent to Ambient Temp.
MAP
Absolute Pressure inside Intake Manifold
Idling: 20 ∼ 51 kPa
Racing without load (2,500 rpm):
17 ∼ 48 kPa
THROTTLE POS
Voltage Output of Throttle Position Sensor
Calculated as a percentage:
0 V → 0%, 5 V → 100 %
Throttle Fully Closed: 6 ∼ 16 %
Throttle Fully Open: 64 ∼ 98 %
O2S B1, S1
Voltage Output of Heated Oxygen Sensor
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Idling: 0.1 ∼ 0.9 V (0.56 ∼ 0.76 V *2)
O2FT B1, S1
Heated Oxygen Sensor Fuel Trim Bank 1
Sensor 1
(Same as SHORT FT #1)
INTAKE AIR
0 ± 20 %
Idling: 2.8 ∼ 3.8 V
A/FS B1, S1 *3
Voltage Output of A/F Sensor
A/FFT B1, S1 *3
A/F Sensor Fuel Trim (Same as SHORT FT #1)
O2S B1, S2
Voltage Output of Heated Oxygen Sensor
Bank 1 Sensor 2
0 ± 20 %
Driving at 50 km/h (31 mph): 0.05 ∼ 0.95 V
*1: If no conditions are specifically stated for ”ldling”, it means the shift lever is at N or P position, the A/C
switch is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
*2: Only for California Specification vehicles, when you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–
held tester).
*3: Only for California Specification vehicles, when you use the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Author:
Date:
249
DI–15
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
TOYOTA Enhanced Signals.
TOYOTA hand–held tester display
Measurement Item
Normal Condition*1
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire range
Misfire 0: 0 rpm
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range
Misfire 0: 0 g/r
Fuel injection time for cylinder No.1
Idling: 2.9 ∼ 5.1 ms
Intake Air Control Valve Duty Ratio
Opening ratio rotary solenoid type IAC valve
Idling: 25 ∼ 62 %
Starter Signal
Cranking: ON
CTP SIG
Closed Throttle Position Signal
Throttle fully closed: ON
A/C SIG
A/C Switch Signal
A/C ON: ON
PNP SIG
Park/Neutral Position Switch Signal
P or N position: ON
Electrical Load Signal
Defogger S/W ON: ON
Stop Light Switch Signal
Stop light switch ON: ON
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Signal
Turn steering wheel: ON
FC IDL
Fuel Cut Idle: Fuel cut when throttle valve fully
closed, during deceleration
Fuel cut operating: ON
FC TAU
Fuel Cut TAU: Fuel cut during very light load
Fuel cut operating: ON
INJECTOR
IAC DUTY RATIO
STARTER SIG
ELECTCL LOAD SIG
STOP LIGHT SW
PS OIL PRESS SW
CYL#1, CYL#2, CYL#3, CYL#4
Abnormal revolution variation for each cylinder
0%
IGNITION
Total number of ignition for every 1,000 revolutions
0 ∼ 2,000 rpm
EGR SYSTEM
EGR system operating condition
Idling: OFF
FUEL PUMP
Fuel Pump Signal
Idling: ON
A/C CUT SIG
A/C Cut Signal
A/C S/W OFF: ON
A/C MAG CLUTCH
A/C Switch Signal
A/C ON: ON
EVAP (PURGE) VSV
EVAP VSV Signal
VSV operating: Avove 30 %
VAPOR PRESS VSV
Vapor Pressure VSV Signal
VSV operating: ON
Total Fuel Trim Bank 1: Average value for fuel
trim system of bank 1
Idling: 0.8 ∼ 1.2 V
O2 LR B1, S1 *2
Heated Oxygen Sensor Lean Rich Bank 1 Sensor 1: Response time for oxygen sensor output to
switch from lean to rich
Idling after warming up: 0 ∼ 1,000 msec.
O2 RL B1, S1 *2
Heated Oxygen Sensor Rich Lean Bank 1 Sensor 1: Response time for oxygen sensor output to
switch from rich to lean
Idling after warming up: 0 ∼ 1,000 msec.
TOTAL FT B1
*1: If no conditions are specifically stated for ”ldling”, it means the shift lever is at N or P position, the A/C
switch is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
*2: Except California Specification vehicles.
Author:
Date:
250
DI–16
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00I–09
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Parameters listed in the chart may not be exactly the same as your reading due to the type of instrument
or other factors.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check in check mode, check the circuit for that code listed
in the table below. For details of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ’’See Page ’’ for the respective ’’DTC No.’’ in the DTC chart.
SAE Controlled:
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0105
(DI–29)
Manifold Absolute
Pressure/Barometric
Pressure Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
P0106
(DI–33)
Manifold Absolute Pressure
Circuit Range/Performance
Problem
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Vacuum line
P0110
(DI–35)
Intake Air Temp. Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Intake air temp. sensor (built into mass air flow meter)
ECM
P0115
(DI–41)
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
P0116
(DI–47)
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Cooling system
P0120
(DI–49)
Throttle/Pedal Position
Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0121
(DI–54)
Throttle/Pedal Position
Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
Throttle position sensor
*2
P0125
(DI–61)
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for
Closed Loop Fuel Control
(Except California Spec.)
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
ECM
*3
P0125
(DI–55)
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for
Closed Loop Fuel Control
(Only for California Spec.)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
ECM
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Slow Response
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
ECM
*2
P0130
(DI–66)
*2
P0133
(DI–71)
*2
P0135
(DI–75)
*1: MIL lights up
*2: Except California specification vehicles
*3: Only for California specification vehicles
Author:
Date:
251
DI–17
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0136
(DI–77)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor
P0141
(DI–75)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Same as DTC P0135
*3
P0171
(DI–84)
System too Lean
(Fuel Trim)
(Except California Spec.)
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
*1
*3
P0172
(DI–84)
System too Rich
(Fuel Trim)
(Except California Spec.)
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
*1
*4
P0171
(DI–79)
System too Lean
(Fuel Trim)
(Only for California Spec.)
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/F sensor
*1
*4
P0172
(DI–79)
System too Rich
(Fuel Trim)
(Only for California Spec.)
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/F sensor
*1
P0300
(DI–89)
Random/Multiple Cylinder
Misfire Detected
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
(DI–89)
Misfire Detected
– Cylinder 1
– Cylinder 2
– Cylinder 3
– Cylinder 4
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel line pressure
EGR
Compression
C
i pressure
Valve clearance not to specification
Valve timing
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Open or short engine wire
Connector connection
ECM
*2
P0325
(DI–97)
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in knock sensor 1 circuit
Knock sensor 1 (looseness)
ECM
*1
P0335
(DI–100)
Crankshaft Position Sensor
”A” Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Starter
ECM
*1
MIL lights up
MIL lights up or blinking
Except California Specification vehicles
Only for California Specification vehicles
Author:
Date:
252
DI–18
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
MIL*1
Memory
Camshaft Position Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Distributor
Starter
ECM
P0401
(DI–105)
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Flow Insufficient Detected
EGR valve stuck closed
Open or short in VSV circuit for EGR
Vacuum or EGR hose disconnected
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
EGR VSV open or close malfunction
ECM
P0402
(DI–113)
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Flow Excessive Detected
EGR valve stuck open
Vacuum or EGR hose is connected to wrong post
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
*2
P0420
(DI–116)
Catalyst System Efficiency
Below Threshold
(Except California Spec.)
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
Heated oxygen sensor
*3
P0420
(DI–119)
Catalyst System Efficiency
Below Threshold
(Only for California Spec.)
Three–way catalystic converter
Open short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
P0440
(DI–122)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Malfunction
Vapor pressure sensor
Fuel tank cap incorrectly installed
Fuel tank cap cracked or damaged
Vacuum hose cracked, holed, blocked, damaged or
disconnected ((1) or (2) in fig. 1)
Hose or tube cracked, holed, damaged or loose seal
((3) in fig. 1)
Fuel tank cracked, holed or damaged
Charcoal canister cracked, holed or damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracked or damaged
P0441
(DI–129)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Incorrect Purge Flow
P0446
(DI–129)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Vent Control
Malfunction
P0450
(DI–142)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor
Malfunction
P0451
(DI–142)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor
(Range/performance)
P0340
(DI–103)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Open or short in VSV circuit for vapor pressure sensor
VSV for vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
Open
O
or short
h t in
i VSV circuit
i it for
f EVAP
VSV for EVAP
Vacuum hose cracks, hole, blocked, damaged or disconnected
((1), (4), (5) holed (6) and (7) in fig. 1)
Charcoal canister cracked, holed or damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracked or damaged
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor
V
pressure sensor
ECM
*1: MIL lights up
*2: Except California Specification vehicles
*3: Only for California Specification vehicles
Author:
Date:
253
DI–19
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
P0500
(DI–145)
P0505
(DI–148)
Detection Item
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Malfunction
Combination meter
Open or short in No.1 vehicle speed sensor circuit
No.1 vehicle speed sensor
ECM
Idle Control System
Malfunction
IAC valve is stuck or closed
Open or short in IAC valve circuit
Open or short in A/C switch circuit
Air intake (hose loose)
ECM
MIL*1
Memory
*1: MIL lights up
2. MANUFACTURER CONTROLLED
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
*2
P1130
(DI–152)
A/F Sensor Circuit
Range/Performance Malfunction
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
ECM
*2
P1133
(DI–157)
A/F Sensor Circuit Response
Malfunction
A/F sensor
*2
P1135
(DI–161)
A/F Sensor Heater Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
ECM
P1300
(DI–163)
Igniter Circuit Malfunction (No.1)
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter to ECM
Ignition coil (No.1)
ECM
P1310
(DI–163)
Igniter Circuit Malfunction (No.2)
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter to ECM
Ignition coil (No.2)
ECM
P1335
(DI–169)
Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(During engine running)
Open short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
ECM
–
*3
P1520
(DI–170)
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
P1600
(DI–173)
ECM BATT Malfunction
Open in back up power source circuit
ECM
*3
P1780
(DI–175)
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Malfunction
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
Trouble Area
*1: MIL lights up
*2: Only for California Specification vehicles
*3: Only for A/T models
Author:
Date:
254
DI–20
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
–
Detection Item
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
*2
B2795
(DI–928)
Unmatched key Code
Immobiliser system
–
*2
B2796
(DI–929)
No Communnication in
Immobiliser system
Immobiliser system
–
*2
B2797
(DI–932)
Communication Malfunction No.1
Immobiliser system
–
*2
B2798
(DI–935)
Communication Malfunction No.2
Immobiliser system
–
*1: –MIL does not light up
*2: Only for w/ engine immobiliser system models
Author:
Date:
255
DI–21
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1JS–03
PARTS LOCATION
Manifold Absolute
Throttle Position Sensor Pressure Sensor
ECM
Combination Meter
Injector
(Speedometer)
Camshaft Position
DLC3
Sensor
Heated Oxygen
DLC1
Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
VSV for EGR
Crankshaft
Position
Sensor
Knock
Sensor 1
A/F Sensor *2
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1) *1
Engine Coolant Temp.
Sensor
Park/Neutral Position
Switch
Ignition Coil (No.1, No.2)
VSV for EVAP
Idle Air Control
Valve
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Charcoal Canister
VSV for
Vapor Pressure Sensor
*1: Except California Specification vehicles
*2: Only for California Specification vehicles
A03431
A03430
A03537
Author:
Date:
256
DI–22
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1JT–03
TERMINALS OF ECM
Without engine immobiliser system
ECM Terminals
E7
E8
E9
D00032
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
BATT (E7 – 1) – E1 (E9 – 14)
B – Y ↔ BR
Always
9 ∼ 14
+ B (E7 – 12) – E1 (E9 – 14)
B – Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON
4.5 ∼ 5.5
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully closed
0.3 ∼ 1.0
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully open
3.2 ∼ 4.9
IG switch ON
3.3 ∼ 3.9
Apply vacuum 26.7 kPa (200 mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg)
2.5 ∼ 3.1
VC (E8 – 1) – E2 (E8 – 9)
VTA (E8 – 11) – E2 (E8 – 9)
PIM (E8 – 2) – E2 (E8 – 9)
LG ↔ BR
B – Y ↔ BR
THA (E8 – 3) – E2 (E8 – 9)
Y – B ↔ BR
Idling, Intake air temp. 20°C (68° F)
0.5 ∼ 3.4
THW (E8 – 4) – E2 (E8 – 9)
G – B ↔ BR
Idling, Engine coolant temp. 80°C (176°F)
0.2 ∼ 1.0
*1 GR ↔ BR
Cranking
6.0 or more
*2 B – O ↔ BR
Cranking
6.0 or more
STA (E7 – 11) – E1 (E9 – 14)
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#10 (E9 – 12) – E01 (E9 – 13)
L ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–89)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#20 (E9 – 11) – E01 (E9 – 13)
R ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–89)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#30 (E9 – 25) – E01 (E9 – 13)
Y ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–89)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#40 (E9 – 24) – E01 (E9 – 13)
W ↔ BR
IGT1 (E9 – 20) – E1 (E9 – 14)
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–89)
B ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–163)
IGT2 (E9 – 19) – E1 (E9 – 14)
Y – R ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–163)
IGF (E9 – 3) – E1 (E9 – 14)
W – R ↔ BR
4.5 ∼ 5.5
IG switch ON, Disconnect ignition coil connector
Pulse generation
(See page DI–163)
Idling
*1: TMC made
*2: TMMK made
Author:
Date:
257
DI–23
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
G(E9 – 5) – NE(E9 – 17)
B–W↔L
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–100)
NE(E9 – 4)
– NE(E9 – 17)
B–R↔L
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–100)
FC (E7 – 14) – E01 (E9 – 13)
G – R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
EGR (E9 – 23) – E01(E9 – 13)
P – B ↔ BR
IG switch ON
0∼3
ISCC (E9 – 9) – E01 (E9 – 13)
B – O ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Disconnect E9 connector of ECM
9∼4
ISCO (E9 –10) – E01(E9 – 13)
W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Disconnect E9 connector of ECM
Below 3.0
*1
OX1 (E8 – 6) – E1 (E9 – 14)
W ↔ BR
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for 2 min. after
warming up
Pulse generation
(See page DI–66)
OX2 (E8 – 5) – E1 (E9 – 14)
B ↔ BR
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for 2 min. after
warming up
Pulse generation
*1
1
HT1 (E9 – 8) – E1 (E9 – 14)
L – Y ↔ BR
HT2 (E9 – 21) – E1 (E9 – 14)
P – B ↔ BR
KNK (E8 – 13) – E1 (E9 – 14)
W ↔ BR
Idling
Below 3.0
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Idling
Below 3.0
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page DI–97)
Idling
IG switch ON
Other shift position in P or N position
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Shift position in P or N position
0 ∼ 3.0
*3
3
NSW (E7 – 22) – E1 (E9 – 14)
B – W ↔ BR
SPD (E7 – 9) – E1 (E9 – 14)
V – W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Rotate driving wheel slowly
TE1 (E8 – 15) – E1 (E9 – 14)
L – W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
G – R ↔ BR
Idling
9 ∼ 14
W (E7 – 5) – E1 (E9 – 14)
EVP (E9 – 22) – E1 (E9 – 14)
TPC (E8 – 8) – E1 (E9 – 14)
PTNK (E8 – 7) – E2 (E8 – 9)
Pulse generation
(See page DI–145)
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
V – W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
V ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
P ↔ BR
IG switch ON, Disconnect vacuum hose from vapor pressure
sensor
2.9 ∼ 3.7
Apply vacuum (less than 66.7 kPa (500 mmHg, 19.7 in.Hg))
Below 0.5
*2
AF (E8 – 6) – E1 (E9 – 14)
W ↔ BR
Always (IG switch ON)
3.3 fixed*4
*2
AF (E8 – 14) – E1 (E9 – 14)
O ↔ BR
Always (IG switch ON)
3.0 fixed*4
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
Except California Specification vehicles
Only for California Specification vehicles
Only for A/T models
The ECM terminal voltage is fixed regardless of the output voltage from the sensor.
Author:
Date:
258
DI–24
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
Idling
*1
1
HTAF (E9 – 2) – E04 (E9 – 15)
G ↔ BR
LOCK IN (E9 – 18)
– E1 (E9 – 14)
W – L ↔ BR
LOCK (E7 – 15) – E1(E9 – 14)
R – W ↔ BR
A/C SW (E7 – 10)
– E1 (E9 – 14)
R – B ↔ BR
PRS (E7 – 13) – E1 (E9 – 14)
G ↔ BR
THR (E8 – 10) – E2 (E8 – 9)
L – R ↔ BR
MGC (E7 – 21) – E01(E9 – 14)
L – Y ↔ BR
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
* STP (E7 – 4) – E1 (E9 – 14)
G – W ↔ BR
ELS (E7 – 2) – E1 (E9 – 14)
B – R ↔ BR
PSSW (E8 – 12)
– E1 (E9 – 14)
B – L ↔ BR
SIL (E7 – 16) – E1 (E9 – 14)
Below 3.0
W ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–190)
A/C compressor is operating
A/C indicator light lights up
Below 4.0
A/C indicator light does not lights up
Below 1.0
A/C switch ON
9 ∼ 14
A/C switch OFF
Below 1.0
A/C pressure is normally
Below 1.0
IG switch ON, A/C evaporator temp. 0°C (32°F)
2.2 ∼ 2.6
IG switch ON, A/C evaporator temp. 15°C (59°F)
1.4 ∼ 1.8
A/C magnetic clutch ON
Below 1.0
9 ∼ 14
A/C magnetic clutch OFF
7.5 ∼ 14
IG switch ON, Brake pedal depressed
IG switch ON, Brake pedal released
Below 1.5
Defogger switch and taillight switch ON
7.5 ∼ 14
Defogger switch and taillight switch OFF
Below 1.5
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
At idling, Turn steering wheel to lock position
Below 3.0
During transmission
Pulse generation
*: Only for A/T models
*1: Only for California Specification vehicles
Author:
Date:
259
DI–25
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
With engine immobiliser system
ECM Terminals
E8
E9
E10
E7
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 1110 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
262524 2322 2120191817 16 1514 16 151413 12 1110 9 12 11 10 9 8 7 22 21 201918 171615 1413 12
A02958
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
BATT (E7 – 2) – E1 (E9 – 24)
B – Y ↔ BR
Always
9 ∼ 14
+ B (E7 – 12) – E1 (E9 – 24)
B – Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON
4.5 ∼ 5.5
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully closed
0.3 ∼ 1.0
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully open
3.2 ∼ 4.9
IG switch ON
3.3 ∼ 3.9
Apply vacuum 26.7 kPa (200 mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg)
2.5 ∼ 3.1
VC (E8 – 1) – E2 (E8 – 9)
VTA (E8 – 10) – E2 (E8 – 9)
PIM (E8 – 2) – E2 (E8 – 9)
LG ↔ BR
B – Y ↔ BR
THA (E8 – 3) – E2 (E8 – 9)
Y – B ↔ BR
Idling, Intake air temp. 20°C (68° F)
0.5 ∼ 3.4
THW (E8 – 4) – E2 (E8 – 9)
G – B ↔ BR
Idling, Engine coolant temp. 80°C (176°F)
0.2 ∼ 1.0
*1 GR ↔ BR
Cranking
6.0 or more
*2 B – O ↔ BR
Cranking
6.0 or more
STA (E7 – 11) – E1 (E9 – 24)
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#10 (E9 – 12)
– E01 (E9 – 13)
L ↔ BR
#20 (E9 – 11)
– E01 (E9 – 13)
R ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–89)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page DI–89)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#30 (E9 – 10)
– E01 (E9 – 13)
Y ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–89)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#40 (E9 – 9) – E01 (E9 – 13)
W ↔ BR
IGT1 (E9 – 23)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
IGT2 (E9 – 22)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–89)
B ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–163)
Y – R ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–163)
4.5 ∼ 5.5
IG switch ON, Disconnect ignition coil connector
IGF (E9 – 17) – E1 (E9 – 24)
W – R ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–163)
Idling
*1: TMC made
*2: TMMK made
Author:
Date:
260
DI–26
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
G(E10 – 11) – NE(E10 – 6)
B–W↔L
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–100)
NE(E10 – 12)
– NE(E10 – 6)
B–R↔L
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–100)
FC (E7 – 14) – E01 (E9 – 13)
G – R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
EGR (E8 – 15) – E01(E9 – 13)
P – B ↔ BR
IG switch ON
0∼3
ISCC (E9 – 6)
– E01 (E9 – 13)
B – O ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Disconnect E9 connector of ECM
9∼4
ISCO (E9 –7) – E01(E9 – 13)
W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Disconnect E9 connector of ECM
Below 3.0
*1
OX1 (E8 – 5) – E1 (E9 – 24)
W ↔ BR
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for 2 min. after
warming up
Pulse generation
(See page DI–66)
OX2 (E8 – 13) – E1 (E9 – 24)
B ↔ BR
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for 2 min. after
warming up
Pulse generation
*1
1
HT1 (E9 – 1) – E1 (E9 – 24)
L – Y ↔ BR
HT2 (E9 – 14) – E1 (E9 – 24)
P – B ↔ BR
KNK (E8 – 12) – E1 (E9 – 24)
W ↔ BR
Idling
Below 3.0
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Idling
Below 3.0
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
(See page DI–97)
Idling
IG switch ON
Other shift position in P or N position
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Shift position in P or N position
0 ∼ 3.0
*3
3
NSW (E7 – 22) – E1 (E9 – 24)
B – W ↔ BR
SPD (E7 – 8) – E1 (E9 – 24)
V – W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Rotate driving wheel slowly
TE1 (E8 – 7) – E1 (E9 – 24)
L – W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
G – R ↔ BR
Idling
9 ∼ 14
W (E7 – 4) – E1 (E9 – 24)
EVP (E9 – 3) – E1 (E9 – 24)
TPC (E8 – 16) – E1 (E9 – 24)
PTNK (E8 – 8) – E2 (E8 – 9)
Pulse generation
(See page DI–145)
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
V – W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
V ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
P ↔ BR
IG switch ON, Disconnect vacuum hose from vapor pressure
sensor
2.9 ∼ 3.7
Apply vacuum (less than 66.7 kPa (500 mmHg, 19.7 in.Hg))
Below 0.5
*2
AF (E8 – 6) – E1 (E9 – 24)
W ↔ BR
Always (IG switch ON)
3.3 fixed*4
*2
AF (E8 – 14) – E1 (E9 – 24)
O ↔ BR
Always (IG switch ON)
3.0 fixed*4
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
Except California Specification vehicles
Only for California Specification vehicles
Only for A/T models
The ECM terminal voltage is fixed regardless of the output voltage from the sensor.
Author:
Date:
261
DI–27
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
Idling
*1
1
HTAF (E9 – 2) – E04 (E9 – 15)
G ↔ BR
LOCK IN (E9 – 19)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
W – L ↔ BR
LOCK (E7 – 20)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
R – W ↔ BR
A/C SW (E7 – 10)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
R – B ↔ BR
PRS (E7 – 19) – E1 (E9 – 24)
G ↔ BR
THR (E8 – 11) – E2 (E8 – 9)
L – R ↔ BR
MGC (E7 – 21)
– E01 (E9 – 13)
L – Y ↔ BR
G – W ↔ BR
ELS (E7 – 13) – E1 (E9 – 24)
B – R ↔ BR
– E1 (E9 – 24)
SIL (E7 – 6) – E1 (E9 – 24)
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
* STP (E7 – 9) – E1 (E9 – 24)
PSSW (E9 – 4)
Below 3.0
B – L ↔ BR
W ↔ BR
TACH (E7 – 7) – E1 (E9 – 24)
B – O ↔ BR
KSW (E10 – 4) – E1 (E9 – 24)
L – B ↔ BR
RXCK (E10 – 3)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
Pulse generation
(See page DI–190)
A/C compressor is operating
A/C indicator light lights up
Below 4.0
A/C indicator light does not lights up
Below 1.0
A/C switch ON
9 ∼ 14
A/C switch OFF
Below 1.0
A/C pressure is normally
Below 1.0
IG switch ON, A/C evaporator temp. 0°C (32°F)
2.2 ∼ 2.6
IG switch ON, A/C evaporator temp. 15°C (59°F)
1.4 ∼ 1.8
A/C magnetic clutch ON
Below 1.0
9 ∼ 14
A/C magnetic clutch OFF
7.5 ∼ 14
IG switch ON, Brake pedal depressed
IG switch ON, Brake pedal released
Below 1.5
Defogger switch and taillight switch ON
7.5 ∼ 14
Defogger switch and taillight switch OFF
Below 1.5
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
At idling, Turn steering wheel to lock position
Below 3.0
During transmission
Pulse generation
Idling
Pulse generation
At the time of inserting key
Below 1.5
In the condition without key inserted
Pulse generation
R – L ↔ BR
At the time of inserting key
Pulse generation
CODE (E10 – 8)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
G – W ↔ BR
At the time of inserting key
Pulse generation
TXCT (E10 – 1)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
L – Y ↔ BR
At the time of inserting key
Pulse generation
IMLD (E10 – 1) – E1 (E9 – 24)
R – Y ↔ BR
In the condition without key inserted
Pulse generation
MREL (E10 – 7)
– E1 (E9 – 24)
B – W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
IGSW (E7 – 1) – E1 (E9 – 24)
B – R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
*: Only for A/T models
*1: Only for California Specification vehicles
Author:
Date:
262
DI–28
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00L–03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Engine does not crank (Does not start)
1. Starter
2. starter relay
ST–2
ST–20
No initial combustion (Does not start)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Engine control module (ECM)
DI–179
DI–183
IN–31
No complete combustion (Does not start)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–183
Engine cranks normally (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Compression
DI–176
DI–183
EM–3
Cold engine (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–176
DI–183
Hot engine (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–176
DI–183
High engine idle speed (Poor idling)
1. A/C switch circuit
2. ECM power source circuit
AC–84
DI–179
Low engine idle speed (Poor idling)
1. A/C switch circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
AC–84
DI–183
Rough idling (Poor idling)
1. Compression
2. Fuel pump control circuit
EM–3
DI–183
Hunting (Poor idling)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–179
DI–183
Hesitation/Poor acceleration (Poor driveability)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
2. A/T faulty
DI–183
DI–405
Surging (Poor driveability)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–183
Soon after starting (Engine stall)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–183
During A/C operation (Engine stall)
1. A/C switch circuit
2. Engine control module (ECM)
AC–84
IN–31
A/C switch indicatior blinking
1. A/C Compressor lock sensor circuit
2. A/C Evaporator temp. sensor circuit
DI–190
DI–192
Unable to refuel/ Difficult to refuel
1. ORVR system
EC–6
Author:
Date:
263
DI–29
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00M–05
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
P0105
Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric
Pressure Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
V
Output Voltage
(3.96)
3.6
2.4
1.2
150
450
20
60
mmHg
750 (840)
kPa
100 (112)
By a built–in sensor unit, the manifold absolute pressure sensor
detects the intake manifold pressure as a voltage. The ECM
then determines the basic injection duration and basic injection
advance angle based on this voltage. Since the manifold absolute pressure sensor does not use the atmospheric pressure as
a criterion, but senses the absolute pressure inside the intake
manifold (the pressure in proportion to the present absolute
vacuum 0), it is not influenced by fluctuations in the atmospheric
pressure due to high altitude and other factors. This permits it
to control the air–fuel ratio at the proper lever under all conditions.
Manifold Absolute Pressure
P01242
DTC No.
P0105
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0105, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the manifold
absolute pressure from the CURRENT DATA.
Manifold Absolute Pressure (kPa)
Approx. 0
130 or more
Malfunction
PIM circuit short
VC circuit open or short
PIM circuit open
E2 circuit open
Author:
Date:
264
DI–30
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Manifold Absolute
Pressure Sensor
ECM
3
Y
1
VC
E8
2
B–Y
2
PIM
E8
1
BR
9
E2
E8
5V
E1
A00309
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction), P0106 (Manifold
Absolute Pressure /Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem) and P0110 (Intake Air
Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0120 (Throttle/Pedal
Position Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be
open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
265
DI–31
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of manifold absolute pressure.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
CHECK:
Read value of the manifold absolute pressure on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Same as atmospheric pressure.
OK
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
NG
2
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
E2 (–)
VC (+)
w/ Immobiliser
NG
BE6653
P23721
A03008
E2 (–)
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
VC (+)
A03407
OK
Author:
Date:
266
DI–32
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminals PIM and E2 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PIM and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 3.3 – 3.9 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
PIM (+)
E2 (+)
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
w/ Immobiliser
BE6653
P23722
A03009
PIM (+)
E2 (+)
A03408
NG
4
Check for open and short in harness and connector between manifold absolute
pressure sensor and ECM.
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace manifold absolute pressure sensor
(See page SF–52).
Author:
Date:
267
DI–33
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00N–04
DTC
P0106
Manifold Absolute Pressure Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction) on page
DI–29.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
After engine is warmed up, conditions (a) and (b) continue with
engine speed 400 ∼ 1,000 rpm
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Throttle valve fully closed
(b) Manifold absolute pressure sensor output > 3.0 V
P0106
Condition (c) and (d) continue with engine speed 2,500 rpm or
less
(2 trip detection logic)
(c) VTA > 1.85
(d) Manifold absolute pressure sensor output < 1.0 V
Manifold absolute pressure
ressure sensor
Vacuum line
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction) on page
DI–29.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction) and P0106 (Manifold Absolute Pressure /Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem) are output simultaneously, manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit may be open. Perform troubleshooting of DTC
P0105 first.
If DTC P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction), P0106 (Manifold
Absolute Pressure /Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem), P0110 (Intake Air
Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction) and P0120 (Throttle/
Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground)
may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0106) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
268
DI–34
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor operation (See page SF–52).
OK
Check vacuum line between intake air chamber
and manifold absolute pressure sensor.
NG
Replace manifold absolute pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
269
DI–35
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00O–05
DTC
P0110
Intake Air Temp. Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
(fig.1)
30
20
10
Resistance kΩ
5
Acceptable
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
– 20
(– 4)
0
(32)
20
(68)
40
(104)
60
(140)
80
100
(176) (212)
Temp.°C (F°)
FI4741
DTC No.
P0110
The intake air temp. sensor is built into the air cleaner cap and
senses the intake air temperature.
A thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value
according to the intake air temperature, the lower the intake air
temperature, the greater the thermistor resistance value, and
the higher the intake air temperature, the lower the thermistor
resistance value (See fig.1).
The air intake temperature sensor is connected to the ECM
(See below). The 5 V power source voltage in the ECM is applied to the intake air temp. sensor from the terminal THA via
a resistor R.
That is, the resistor R and the intake air temp. sensor are connected in series. When the resistance value of the intake air
temp. sensor changes in accordance with changes in the intake
air temperature, the potential at terminal THA also changes.
Based on this signal, the ECM increases the fuel injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine operation.
If the ECM detects the DTC P0110, it operates the fail safe function in which the intake air temperature is assumed to be 20°C
(68°F).
DTC Detecting Condition
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Trouble Area
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0110, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the intake
air temperature from the CURRENT DATA.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
–40°C (–40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
Author:
Date:
270
DI–36
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Intake Air Temp. Sensor
2
Y–B
3
THA
E8
1
BR
9
E8
5V
R
E2
E1
A00310
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction), P0106 (Manifold Absolute Pressure /Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem), P0110 (Intake Air
Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction) and P0120 (Throttle/
Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground)
may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
271
DI–37
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of intake
air temperature.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Same as actual air intake temperature.
HINT:
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates – 40°C (– 40°F).
If there is short circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
NG
–40°C (–40°F) .... Go to step 2.
140°C (284°F) or more .... Go to step 4.
OK
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
2
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
ECM
5V
2
3
1
9
E8
E8
THA
E2
E1
A00391
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the intake air temp. sensor connector.
(b) Connect the sensor wire harness terminals together.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temp. value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
OK:
Temp. value: 140°C (284°F) or more
OK
Confirm good connection at sensor. If OK, replace intake air temp. sensor.
NG
Author:
Date:
272
DI–38
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
ECM
5V
3
E8
THA
9
E8
E2
E1
w/o Immobiliser
THA
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Connect between terminals THA and E2 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The intake air temp. sensor connector is disconnected.
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector (See page IN–31).
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
E2
w/ Immobiliser
THA
A03010
E2
A03409
OK
Open in harness between terminals E2 or THA,
repair or replace harness.
NG
Confirm good connection at ECM. If OK,
check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
273
DI–39
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for short in harness and ECM.
ON
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
2
1
ECM
5V
3
E8
9
E8
THA
E2
E1
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the intake air temp. sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: –40°C (–40°F)
A00393
OK
Replace intake air temp. sensor.
NG
Author:
Date:
274
DI–40
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for short in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
5V
THA
E2
E1
w/o Immobiliser
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E8 connector from the ECM.
HINT:
The intake air temp. sensor connector is disconnected.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: –40°C (–40°F)
E8 Connector
w/ Immobiliser
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector.
E8 Connector
A03011
A03410
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
275
DI–41
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00P–05
DTC
P0115
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temp. sensor changes the resistance value according to the engine
coolant temp.
The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction shown on page DI–35.
If the ECM detects the DTC P0115, it operates fail safe function in which the engine coolant temperature
is assumed to be 80°C (176°F).
DTC No.
P0115
Detection Item
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Trouble Area
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0115, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the engine
coolant temp. from the CURRENT DATA.
Temp. Displayed
Malfunction
–40°C (–40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
Author:
Date:
276
DI–42
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Coolant Temp.
Sensor
5V
2
G–B
4
THW
E8
1
BR
9
E8
R
E2
E1
A00310
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction), P0106 (Manifold Absolute Pressure /Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem), P0110 (Intake Air
Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction) and P0120 (Throttle/
Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground)
may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
277
DI–43
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of
engine coolant temperature.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Same as actual engine coolant temperature
HINT:
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates –40°C (–40°F).
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
NG
–40°C (–40°F) ... Go to step 2.
140°C (284°F) or more ... Go to step 4.
OK
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
2
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
5V
2
1
4
E8
9
E8
THW
E2
E1
A00395
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the engine coolant temp. sensor connector.
(b) Connect the sensor wire harness terminals together.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
OK
Confirm good connection at sensor. If OK, replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
NG
Author:
Date:
278
DI–44
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
2
ECM
E8
1
5V
4
9
E8
THW
E2
E1
w/o Immobiliser
OK
E2
THW
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Connect between terminals THW and E2 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The engine coolant temp. sensor connector is disconnected.
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector (See page IN–31).
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
Open in harness between terminals E2 or THW,
repair or replace harness.
w/ Immobiliser
THW
A03012
E2
A03411
NG
Confirm good connection at ECM. If OK,
check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
279
DI–45
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for short in harness and ECM.
ON
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
ECM
5V
4
E8
9
E8
THW
E2
E1
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the engine coolant temp. sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: – 40°C (– 40°F)
A00397
OK
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
NG
Author:
Date:
280
DI–46
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for short in harness or ECM.
ON
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
5V
THW
E2
E1
w/o Immobiliser
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E8 connector from the ECM.
HINT:
The engine coolant temp. sensor connector is disconnected.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: –40°C (–40°F)
E8 Connector
w/ Immobiliser
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector.
E8 Connector
A03011
A03412
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
281
DI–47
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00Q–05
DTC
P0116
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Range/
Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–41.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
If THW < –7°C (19.4°F) or THA < –7°C (19.4°F) 20 min. or
more after starting engine, engine coolant temp. sensor value
is 30°C (86°F)*1 20°C (48°F)*2 or less
(2 trip detection logic)
If THW –7°C (19.4°F) and THA –7°C (19.4°F) and 10°C
(50°F) at engine start, 5 min. or more after starting engine,
engine coolant temp. sensor value is 30°C (86°F)*1 20°C
(48°F)*2 or less
(2 trip detection logic)
P0116
If THW 10°C (50°F) and THA 10°C (50°F) at engine
start, 2 min. or more after starting engine, engine coolant temp.
sensor value is 30°C (86°F)*1 20°C (48°F)*2 or less
(2 trip detection logic)
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Cooling system
When THW 35°C (95°F) and 60°C (140°F), THA
–6.7°C (19.9°F) when starting the engine, condition (a) and
(b) continues:
(a) Vehicle speed is changing (Not stable)
(b) Water temperature change is lower than 3°C (37.4°F) from
the water temperature since when sterting the engine
(2 trip detection logic)
*1: Except California Specification vehicles.
*2: Only for California Specification vehicles.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction) and P0116 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit
Range/Performance Problem) are output simultaneously, engine coolant temp. sensor circuit may be
open. Perform troubleshooting of DTC P0115 first.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0116) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
282
DI–48
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check thermostat (See page CO–10).
NG
Replace thermostat.
OK
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
Author:
Date:
283
DI–49
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00R–05
DTC
P0120
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A”
Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Throttle Position
Sensor
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and
detects the throttle valve opening angle. When the throttle valve
is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.3 ∼ 0.8 V is applied
to terminal VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to the opening
angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 3.2 ∼ 4.9
V when the throttle valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the
vehicle driving conditions from this signal input from terminal
VTA, and uses it as one of the conditions for deciding the air–
fuel ratio correction, power increase correction and fuel–cut
control etc.
ECM
VC
VTA
E2
P24296
DTC No.
P0120
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Condition (a) or (b) continues with more than 5 sec.:
(a) VTA < 0.1 V
(b) VTA > 4.9 V
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0120, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the throttle
valve opening percentage.
Throttle valve opening position
expressed as percentage
Trouble Area
Throttle valve fully closed
Throttle valve fully open
0%
0%
VC line open
VTA line open or short
Approx. 100 %
Approx. 100 %
E2 line open
Author:
Date:
284
DI–50
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Throttle Position Sensor
ECM
1
Y
3
LG
1
VC
E8
10 11
E8 E8
5V
VTA
(*1) (*2)
2
BR
9
E2
E8
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A03595
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction), P0106 (Manifold Absolute Pressure /Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem), P0110 (Intake Air
Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction) and P0120 (Throttle/
Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction) are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground)
may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
285
DI–51
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, read the throttle valve
opening percentage.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the throttle valve opening percentage.
OK:
FI7052
OK
Throttle valve
Throttle valve opening position
expressed as percentage
Fully open
Approx. 70 %
Fully closed
Approx. 10 %
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
NG
2
Check voltage between terminal VC of throttle position sensor connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal VC of the throttle position
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
ON
VC (+)
A00369
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
286
DI–52
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check throttle position sensor (See page SF–29).
NG
Replace throttle position sensor.
OK
4
Check voltage between terminals VTA and E2 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals VTA and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
ON
w/o Immobiliser
VTA
(+)
E2
(–)
Throttle valve
Voltage
Fully closed
0.3 ∼ 1.0 V
Fully open
3.2 ∼ 4.9 V
w/ Immobiliser
A03013
VTA
(+)
E2
(–)
A03413
NG
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and throttle position sensor (VTA or E2 line) (See page IN–31).
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
287
DI–53
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
VC
(+)
E2
(–)
w/ Immobiliser
A03008
E2
(–)
VC
(+)
A03414
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and sensor (VC line)
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
288
DI–54
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00S–04
DTC
P0121
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A”
Circuit Range/Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0120 (Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch "A" Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–49.
DTC No.
P0121
Detection Item
Trouble Area
After vehicle speed has been exceeded 30 km/h (19 mph)
even once, output value of throttle position sensor is out of
applicable range while vehicle speed between 30 km/h (19
mph) and 0 km/h (0 mph)
(2 trip detection logic)
Throttle position sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0121) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Replace throttle position sensor.
Author:
Date:
289
DI–55
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1JU–03
DTC
P0125
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop
Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three–way
catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three–way catalytic converter, the air–fuel
ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio.
The A/F sensor has the characteristic that provides output voltage* approximately proportional to the existing air–fuel ratio. The A/F sensor output voltage* is used to provide feedback for the ECM to control the air–
fuel ratio.
By the A/F sensor output, the ECM can determine the deviation amount from the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio
and control the proper injection time immediately. If the A/F sensor is malfunctioning, ECM is unable to perform accurate air–fuel ratio control.
The A/F sensor is equipped with a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is controlled by the
ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temp. of the exhaust gas is low), current flows to the heater
to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
*: The voltage value changes at the inside of the ECM only.
Platinum
Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platinum
Electrode
ECM Monitored
A/F Sensor Voltage
Atmosphere
Heater
Coating (Ceramic)
(V)
4.0
3.8
3.6
3.4
3.2
3.0
2.8
2.6
2.4
12 13 14
15 16 17 18 19
Air–Fuel Ratio
Cover
Exhaust Gas
A00477
DTC No.
P0125
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up, A/F sensor output* does not
change when conditions (a), (b), and (c) continue for at least
1.5 min.:
*: Output value changes at inside of ECM only
(a) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more
(b) Vehicle speed: 40 ∼ 100 km/h (25 ∼ 62 mph)
(c) Throttle valve is not fully closed
Trouble Area
Fuel system
Injector
Ignition system
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
ECM
Author:
Date:
290
DI–56
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0125, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester to confirm voltage
output of A/F sensor from the CURRENT DATA.
The ECM controls the voltage of AF and AF terminals of ECM to the fixed voltage. Therefore, it
is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
J27
2
5
J/C
2
3
6
1
7
W–R
2
MAIN FL
II3
4
II2
II4
4
G (*3)
*3: California
*4: Except California
1
B
2 HTAF
E9
13 5
OX2
E8 E8
E04
(*2) (*1)
E1
B–W (*5) 14 AF
O (*6)
E8 3.0V
(*3)
12
P–B
14 21 HT2
E9 E9
(*2) (*1)
EC
*5:TMC Made
6
1
II3
Heated
Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 1
BR
Sensor 2)
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
Battery
3
AF
3.3V
BR
FL
1 Block 1
F4
F6
B
W–R
2L 4
B
5 1K 3 1K
EB
B–G
1 2A
5
1B
2
(*3)
6
E8
to Analog–Digital
Converter
A/F
Sensor
7 1W
4
W–B
2F
AM2
EFI
EFI
Relay
L (*5)
W(*6)
IGN
Instrument
Panel J/B
1
3
ECM
J27
2K 7
2 2J
Engine Room R/B No.2
J27
B–R (*1)
J/C
B–W(*2)
B–Y
P–B
J27
II3
E
B–R
B
IG Switch
B–Y
B–Y
B
J19 J/C
B (*3)
B–Y
B
B
E
B–Y
9
B–Y
*6:TMMK Made
B–W(*2)
E03
7
E10 MREL
(*2)
A03597
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If the vehicle run out fuel, the air–fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0125 will be recorded.
The MIL then comes on.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
291
DI–57
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0125) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value for voltage output of A/F sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read voltage value of the A/F sensor on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester when
you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of AF terminal of ECM is 3.3 V fixed and the A/F terminal is 3.0 V fixed. Therefore, it is impossible to check the A/F sensor output voltage at the terminals (AF/AF) of ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage Value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle valve
open and close
Not remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V)
Not remains at 3.8
3 8 V (* 0.76
0 76 V) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is below 2.8 V (* 0.56
V), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is above 3.8 V (* 0.76 V), it
is normal.
If output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V) even after performing all the above
conditions, A/F the sensor circuit may be open.
If output voltage of A/F sensor remains at 3.8 V (* 0.76 V) or more, or 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less even after
performing all the above conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 10.
NG
Author:
Date:
292
DI–58
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
4
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (See page SF–59).
NG
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
5
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Replace or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
Author:
Date:
293
DI–59
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check injector injection (See page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
9
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace A/F sensor.
10
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–152).
Go
11
Is there DTC P0125 being output again?
YES
Check and replace ECM.
NO
Author:
Date:
294
DI–60
DIAGNOSTICS
12
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past?
NO
Check for intermittent problems.
YES
DTC P0125 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
295
DI–61
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00T–05
DTC
P0125
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop
Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three–way
catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three–way catalytic converter, the air–fuel
ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio.
The heated oxygen sensor has the characteristic where by its output voltage changes suddenly in the vicinity
of the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio. This is used to detect the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas and
provide feedback to the computer for control of the air–fuel ratio.
When the air–fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust increases and the heated
oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (small electromotive force: 0 V).
When the air–fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas is reduced and the heated oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (large electromotive force: 1 V).
The ECM judges by the electromotive force from the heated oxygen sensor whether the air–fuel ratio is RICH
or LEAN and controls the injection time accordingly. However, if malfunction of the heated oxygen sensor
causes output of abnormal electromotive force, the ECM is unable to perform accurate air–fuel ratio control.
The heated oxygen sensors include a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is controlled by
the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is low) current flows to the
heater to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
Ideal Air–Fuel Mixture
Flange
Platinum Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platinum Electrode
Heater
Coating (Ceramic)
Output Voltage
Atmosphere
Richer – Air Fuel Ratio – Leaner
Cover
Exhaust Gas
P21242 FI7210
DTC No.
P0125
A00027
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up, heated oxygen sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) output does not indicate RICH even once when
conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for at least 1.5 min.:
(a) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more
(b) Vehicle speed: 40 ∼ 100 km/h (25 ∼ 62 mph)
(c) Throttle valve does not fully closed
Trouble Area
Fuel system
Injector
Ignition system
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
ECM
Author:
Date:
296
DI–62
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0125, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester to confirm voltage output
of the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) from the CURRENT DATA.
If voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) is 0 V, heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor
1) circuit may be open or short.
B–Y
WIRING DIAGRAM
B–Y
B–Y
B J/C
J27
J19 J/C
9
II3
B
B–Y
J27
(*3)
B–Y
ECM
B–Y
E
E
J27
J27
B
B–Y
B
W
B–R (*1)
1 2A
EB
2L 4
B–R
5 1K 3 1K
2
6
1
7
(*2)
(*1)
4
L–Y
(*3)
1
8 HT1
E9 E9
(*2)
B
(*1)
E03
13 5 OX2
E8 E8
(*2)
(*1)
E1
12
II2
BR
FL
MAIN
6
1
II3
3 Heated
Oxygen
Sensor
4 (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
Battery
2
BR
II3
BR
FL
1 Block 1
F6
F4
B–G
W–R
3
5
6
OX1
E8 E8
E1
1
B
P–B
AM2
4
W–B
2F
W–R
2
EFI
5
5
1B
IG Switch
EFI
Relay
IGN
Instrument
Panel J/B
1
7 1W
BR
2K 7
3
B
B–W(*2)
Engine Room R/B No.2
2 2J
2
Heated
Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 1
Sensor 1)
(*3)
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
*3: Except California
(*3)
P–B
14 21 HT2
E9 E9
(*2)
EC
B–W (*2)
II4
(*1)
E03
7
E10 MREL
(*2)
A03596
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If the vehicle run out fuel, the air–fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0125 will be recorded.
The MIL then comes on.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
297
DI–63
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0125) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value for voltage output of heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the engine to normal operating temp. (above 75°C (169°F)).
CHECK:
Read voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) when the engine is suddenly raced.
HINT:
Perform quick racing to 4,000 rpm 3 times using the accelerator pedal.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) output a RICH signal (0.45 V or more) at least once.
OK
Go to step 10.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
298
DI–64
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check whether misfire is occurred or not by monitoring DTC and data list.
NG
Perform troubleshooting for misfire
(See page DI–163).
OK
5
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
8
Check injector injection (See page SF–23)
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Author:
Date:
299
DI–65
DIAGNOSTICS
9
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace oxygen sensor
(bank 1 sensor 1).
10
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–152).
Go
11
Is there DTC P0125 being output again?
YES
Check and replace ECM.
NO
12
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past?
NO
Check for intermittent problems.
YES
DTC P0125 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
300
DI–66
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00V–05
DTC
P0130
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1) (Except California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)) on
page DI–55.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0130
Voltage output of heated oxygen sensor remains at 0.4 V or
more, or 0.55 V or less, during idling after engine is warmed up
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
HINT:
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
The heated oxygen sensor’s output voltage and the short−term fuel trim value can be read using the OBD
II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)) on
page DI–55.
Author:
Date:
301
DI–67
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle speed
50 ∼ 65 km/h
(31 ∼ 40 mph)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(4)
(5)
(3)
(1) (2)
1 ∼ 3 min.
1 min.
Time
A01666
(1) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from normal mode to check mode (See page DI–3).
(3) Start the engine and warm it up with all accessory switches OFF.
(4) Drive the vehicle at 50 ∼ 65 km/h (31 ∼ 40 mph) for 1 ∼ 3 min. to warm up the heated oxygen sensor.
(5) Let the engine idle for 1 min.
(6) Perform steps (3) to (5) three times.
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will light up during step (6).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction will not be possible.
If you do not have a TOYOTA hand–held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps
(3) to (6), then perform steps (3) to (6) again.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0130) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
302
DI–68
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check the output voltage of heated oxygen sensor during idling.
PREPARATION:
Warm up the heated oxygen sensor the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor during idling.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage:
Alternates repeatedly between less than 0.4 V and more than 0.55 V (See the following table).
P18349
OK
Go to step 8.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and oxygen
sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
303
DI–69
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
6
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
7
Check injector injection (See page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace oxygen sensor
(bank 1 sensor 1).
Author:
Date:
304
DI–70
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–152).
Go
9
Is there DTC P0130 being output again?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
YES
Check and Replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
305
DI–71
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI4NF–01
DTC
P0133
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 1 Sensor 1) (Ex. CA Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)) on
page DI–55.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0133
Response time for heated oxygen sensor’s voltage output to
change from rich to lean, or from lean to rich, is 1 sec. or more
during idling after engine is warmed up
(2 trip detection logic)
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
HINT:
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scantool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0133) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
306
DI–72
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check output voltage of heated oxygen sensor during idling.
PREPARATION:
Warm up the heated oxygen sensor the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor during idling.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage:
Alternates repeatedly between less than 0.4 V and more than 0.55 V (See the following table).
P18349
OK
Go to step 8.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and oxygen
sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
307
DI–73
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Replace EGR system.
OK
6
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
7
Check injector injection (See page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace oxygen sensor
(bank 1 sensor 1).
Author:
Date:
308
DI–74
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–152).
Go
9
Is there DTC P0133 being output again?
NG
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
YES
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
309
DI–75
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00X–04
DTC
P0135
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 1) (Ex. CA Spec.)
DTC
P0141
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)) on
page DI–55.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0135
P0141
When heater operates, heater current exceeds 2 A
(2 trip detection logic)
P0135
P0141
Heater current of 0.2 A or less when heater operates
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated
H t d oxygen sensor heater
h t
ECM
HINT:
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farther away from the engine body.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)) on
page DI–55.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
310
DI–76
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminals HT1, HT2 of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals HT1, HT2 of the ECM connector and body ground.
HINT:
Connect terminal HT1 to bank 1 sensor 1.
Connect terminal HT2 to bank 1 sensor 2.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
HT1
HT2
w/ Immobiliser
HT1
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
HT2
A03014
A03415
NG
2
Check resistance of heated oxygen sensor heaters
(See pages SF–61, SF–63).
NG
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
OK
Check and repair harness or connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and heated oxygen
sensor, and heated oxygen sensor and ECM. (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
311
DI–77
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI00Y–08
DTC
P0136
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)) on
page DI–55.
DTC No.
P0136
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Voltage output of heated oxygen sensor remains at
0.45*1/0.40*2 V or more, or 0.60*1/0.50*2 V or less when vehicle is driven at 40 km/h (25 mph) or more after engine is
warmed up
*1: for California Spec.
*2: except California Spec.
(2 trip detection logic).
Heated oxygen sensor
HINT:
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farther away from the engine body.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)) on
page DI–55.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0136) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
312
DI–78
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check output voltage of heated oxygen sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the engine to normal operating temp.
CHECK:
Read voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor when the engine suddenly raced.
HINT:
Perform quick racing to 4,000 rpm 3 min. using the accelerator pedal.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage:
Alternates from 0.45*1/0.40* 2 V or less to 0.60*1/0.50* 2 V or more.
*1: for California Spec.
*2: except California Spec.
OK
Check that each connector is properly
connected.
NG
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
Author:
Date:
313
DI–79
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1JW–03
DTC
P0171
System too Lean (Fuel Trim)
(Only for California Spec.)
DTC
P0172
System too Rich (Fuel Trim)
(Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection time. Fuel trim
includes short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim.
Short–term fuel trim is the short–term fuel compensation used to maintain the air–fuel ratio at its ideal
theoretical value.
The signal from the A/F sensor is approximately proportional to the existing air–fuel ratio, and ECM comparing it with the ideal theoretical value, the ECM reduces fuel volume immediately if the air–fuel ratio is rich
and increases fuel volume if it is lean.
Long–term fuel trim compensates the deviation from the central value of the short–term fuel trim stored up
by each engine tolerance, and the deviation from the central value due to the passage of time and changes
of using environment.
If both the short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim exceed a certain value, it is detected as a malfunction
and the MIL lights up.
DTC No.
P0171
P0172
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When air–fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on rich side
(2 trip detection logic)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Air intake (loose hoses)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/F sensor
When air–fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on lean side
(2 trip detection logic)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/F sensor
HINT:
When the DTC P0171 is recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the lean side. When DTC P0172 is
recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the rich side.
If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air–fuel ratio is lean and DTC P0171 is recorded. The MIL then comes
on.
If the total of the short–term fuel trim value and long–term fuel trim value is within ± 38 %, the system
is functioning normally.
The A/F sensor output voltage and the short–term fuel trim value can be read using the OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
The ECM controls the voltage of AF and AF terminals of ECM to the fixed voltage. Therefore, it
is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
Author:
Date:
314
DI–80
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air¯fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check injector injection (See page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
3
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor and engine coolant temp. sensor
(See pages SF–53 and SF–49).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
4
Check for spark and ignition (See page IG–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
315
DI–81
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, pressure regulator,
fuel pipe line and filter.
OK
6
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
316
DI–82
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check output voltage of A/F sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read voltage value of A/F sensor on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester when you
perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of AF terminal of ECM is 3.3 V fixed and AF terminal is 3.0 V fixed. Therefore, it is impossible
to check the A/F sensor output voltage at the terminals (AF/AF) of ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle valve
open and close
Not remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V)
Not remains at 3
3.8
8 V (* 0
0.76
76 V) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less
*: When you use OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensor is below 2.8 V (* 0.56 V),
it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensor is above 3.8 V (* 0.76 V), it is normally.
If output voltage of A/F sensor remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V) even after performing all the above conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be open.
If output voltage of A/F sensor remains at 3.8 V (* 0.76 V) or more, or 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less even after
performing all the above conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
Author:
Date:
317
DI–83
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and oxygen
sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace A/F sensor.
9
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–152).
Go
10
Is there DTC P0171 or P0172 being output again?
YES
Check and replace ECM.
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past?
NO
Check for intermittent problems.
YES
DTC P0171 or P0172 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
318
DI–84
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI4NG–01
DTC
P0171
System too Lean (Fuel Trim)
(Except California Spec.)
DTC
P0172
System too Rich (Fuel Trim)
(Except California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection time. Fuel trim
includes short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim.
Short–term fuel trim is the short–term fuel compensation used to maintain the air–fuel ratio at its ideal
theoretical value. The signal from the heated oxygen sensor indicates whether the air–fuel ratio is RICH or
LEAN compared to the ideal theoretical value, triggering a reduction in fuel volume if the air–fuel ratio is rich,
and an increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
Long–term fuel trim is overall fuel compensation carried out long–term to compensate for continual deviation
of the short–term fuel trim from the central value due to individual engine differences, wear over time and
changes in the usage environment.
If both the short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim are LEAN or RICH beyond a certain value, it is
detected as a malfunction and the MIL lights up.
DTC No.
P0171
P0172
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When air–fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on RICH side
(2 trip detection logic)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
When air–fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on LEAN side
(2 trip detection logic)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
HINT:
When the DTC P0171 is recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the LEAN side. When DTC P0172 is
recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the RICH side.
If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air–fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0171 is recorded. The MIL then
comes on.
If the total of the short–term fuel trim value and long–term fuel trim value is within ± 38 %, the system
is functioning normally.
The heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) output voltage and the short–term fuel trim value can
be read using the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Author:
Date:
319
DI–85
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check injector injection (See page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
3
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor and engine coolant temp. sensor
(See pages SF–53 and SF–49).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
4
Check for spark and ignition (See page IG–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
320
DI–86
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, pressure regulator,
fuel pipe line and filter.
OK
6
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
321
DI–87
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check the output voltage of heated oxygen sensor during idling.
PREPARATION:
Warm up the heated oxygen sensor the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensor during idling.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage:
Alternates repeatedly between less than 0.4 V and more than 0.55 V (See the following table).
P18349
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
8
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and oxygen
sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace oxygen sensor.
Author:
Date:
322
DI–88
DIAGNOSTICS
9
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–66).
Go
10
Is there DTC P0171 or P0172 being output again?
YES
Check and replace ECM.
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past?
NO
Check for intermittent problems.
YES
DTC P0171 or P0172 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
323
DI–89
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI011–07
DTC
P0300
Random/Multiple Cylinder Misfire Detected
DTC
P0301
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0302
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0303
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0304
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Misfire: The ECM uses the crankshaft position sensor and camshaft position sensor to monitor changes in
the crankshaft rotation for each cylinder.
The ECM counts the number of times the engine speed change rate indicates that misfire has occurred. And
when the misfire rate equals or exceeds the count indicating that the engine condition has deteriorated, the
MIL lights up.
If the misfire rate is high enough and the driving conditions will cause catalyst overheating, the MIL blinks
when misfiring occurs.
DTC No.
P0300
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
DTC Detecting Condition
Misfiring
Mi
fi i off random
d
cylinders
li d
is
i detected
d t t d during
d i any particular
ti l
200 or 1,000 revolutions
For any particular 200 revolutions for engine, misfiring is detected which can cause catalyst overheating
(This causes MIL to blink)
Trouble Area
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel line pressure
EGR
Compression pressure
Valve clearance not to specification
Valve timing
Manifold absolute pressure
ressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Open or short in engine wire
Connector connection
ECM
HINT:
When the 2 or more codes for a misfiring cylinder are recorded repeatedly but no random misfire code is
recorded, it indicates that the misfires were detected and recorded at different times.
Author:
Date:
324
DI–90
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument
Panel J/B
B–R
IG Switch
7
8
1C
B–R
B–R
W–R
5
1K
5 1B
Injector
2
B
B
B–R
J21
J/C
2
B
Battery
W–R
AM2
MAIN
FL
1
R
B–R
1 Y
No. 3
2
1 W
12
#10
E9
BR
Engine Room
J/B No. 2
11
E9
BR
#20
10
25
E9
E9
(*2)
(*1)
9
E9
24
#40
E9
(*2)
No. 4
F4 1
F6 1
L
No. 2
4 2L
FL
Block
1
No. 1
B–R
B
B–G
2
B
12 II3
B–R
6
3
1K
ECM
#30
(*1)
13
E9
26
E9
E01
E02
1 2A
B
EC
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A03626
Author:
Date:
325
DI–91
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(1) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool.
(2) Record DTC and the freeze frame data.
(3) Use the TOYOTA hand–held tester to set to Check Mode. (See page DI–3)
(4) Drive the vehicle several times with the engine speed, load and its surrounding range shown with
ENGINE SPD, CALC LOAD in the freeze frame data or MISFIRE RPM, MISFIRE LOAD in the data list.
If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is simulated
the first time. Then repeat the simulation process again.
HINT:
In order to memorize DTC of misfire, it is necessary to drive around MISFIRE RPM, MISFIRE LOAD in the
data list for the following period of time.
Engine Speed
Time
Idling
3 minutes 30 seconds or more
1000 rpm
3 minutes or more
2000 rpm
1 minutes 30 seconds or more
3000 rpm
1 minutes or more
(5) Check whether there is misfire or not by monitoring DTC and the freeze frame data. After that, record
them.
(6) Turn the ignition switch OFF and wait at least 5 seconds.
Author:
Date:
326
DI–92
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If is the case that DTC besides misfire is memorized simultaneously, first perform the troubleshooting
for them.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
data records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful
for determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
When the vehicle is brought to the workshop and the misfire is not occurred, misfire can be confirmed
by reproducing the condition or freeze frame data. Also, after finishing the repair, confirm that there
is no misfire. (See the confirmation driving pattern)
When either of SHORT FT #1, LONG FT #1, SHORT FT #2 or LONG FT #2 in the freeze frame data
is besides the range of ±20%, there is a possibility that the air–fuel ratio is inclining either to ”rich”
(–20% or less) or ”lean” (+20% or more).
When COOLANT TEMP in the freeze frame data is less than 80°C (176°F), there is a possibility or
misfire only during warming up.
In the case that misfire cannot be reproduced, the reason may be because of the driving with lack or
fuel, the use of improper fuel, a stain of ignition plug, and etc.
1
Check wire harness, connector and vacuum hose in engine room.
CHECK:
(a) Check the connection conditions of the wire harness and connector.
(b) Check the disconnection, piping and break of the vacuum hose.
NG
Repair or replace, then confirm that there is no
misfire (See the confirmation driving pattern).
OK
Author:
Date:
327
DI–93
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check spark plug and spark of misfiring cylinder.
A00434
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the high–tension cord from the spark plug.
(b) Remove the spark plug.
CHECK:
(a) Check the plug type.
(b) Check the electrode for carbon deposits.
(c) Check the electrode gap.
OK:
(a) Platinum–tipped spark plugs with twin ground
electrodes.
Recommended spark plug:
ND made: PK20TR11
NGK made: BKR6EKPB–11
(b) No large carbon deposit present.
Not wet with gasoline or oil.
(c) Electrode gap: 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
PREPARATION:
(a) Install the spark plug to the high–tension code.
(b) Disconnect the injector connector.
(c) Ground the spark plug.
CHECK:
Check if spark occurs while the engine is being cracked.
NOTICE: To prevent excess fuel being injected from the injectors during this test, don’t crank the engine for more
than 5 ∼ 10 seconds at a time.
OK:
Spark jumps across electrode gap.
NG
Replace or check ignition system
(See page IG–1).
OK
Author:
Date:
328
DI–94
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage of ECM terminal for injector of failed cylinder.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between applicable terminal of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
#10 (+)
#20 (+)
#30 (+)
#40 (+)
w/ Immobiliser
#10 (+) #20 (+) #30 (+) #40 (+)
A03015
A03416
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
INJECTOR SIGNAL WAVEFORM
With the engine idling, measure between terminals #10 ∼ #40 and E01 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The correct waveforms are shown.
Injector Signal Waveform
(Magnification)
10 V/
Division
10 V/
Division
GND
GND
100 msec./Division (Idling)
Injection duration
FI6588 FI6538
1 msec./Division (Idling)
A00064
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
Author:
Date:
329
DI–95
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check resistance of injector of misfiring cylinder (See page SF–20).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between injector and ECM
(See page IN–31).
5
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, pressure regulator, fuel pipe line and filter.
OK
6
Check injector injection (See page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
7
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
Author:
Date:
330
DI–96
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor and engine coolant temp. sensor
(See pages SF–53 AND SF–49).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check compression pressure, valve
clearance and valve timing
(See pages EM–3, EM–4 AND EM–23).
Author:
Date:
331
DI–97
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI012–10
DTC
P0325
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The knock sensor is fitted to the cylinder block to detect engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block
vibrates due to knocking. If engine knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
DTC No.
P0325
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No knock sensor 1 signal to ECM with engine speed, 1,200
rpm or more
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in knock sensor 1 circuit
Knock sensor 1 (looseness)
ECM
HINT:
If the ECM detects above diagnosis conditions, it operates the fail safe function in which the corrective retard
angle value is set to the maximum value.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Knock Sensor 1
1
W
12
E8
13
KNK
E8
(*2)
(*1)
E1
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A03598
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
332
DI–98
DIAGNOSTICS
1
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check continuity between terminal KNK of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E8 connector from the ECM.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal KNK of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
LOCK
w/o Immobiliser
E8 Connector
KNK
OK
w/ Immobiliser
E8 Connector
A03016
–
Go to step 3.
KNK
A03417
NG
2
Check knock sensor 1 (See page SF–57).
NG
Replace knock sensor 1.
OK
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and knock
sensor 1 (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
333
DI–99
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Does malfunction disappear when good knock sensor 1 is installed?
YES
Replace knock sensor 1.
NO
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
With the engine racing (4,000 rpm), measure between terminal
KNK of the ECM connector and body ground.
HINT:
The correct waveforms are as shown.
KNK Signal Waveform
0.5 V/
Division
0V
5 msec./Division
0.5 V/
Division
0V
100 sec./Division
A00406
Spread the time on the horizontal axis, and confirm that period
of the wave is 132 µsec.
(Normal mode vibration frequency of knock sensor:
7.6 kHz)
HINT:
If normal mode vibration frequency is not 7.6 kHz the sensor is
malfunctioning.
Author:
Date:
334
DI–100
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI013–10
DTC
P0335
Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Crankshaft position sensor (NE signal) consist of a signal plate and pickup coil.
The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34
signals of every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the G signals,
and the actual crankshaft angle the engine speed by the NE signals.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
P0335
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine
speed 600 rpm or more
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit.
Crankshaft
C k h ft position
iti sensor
Starter
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Camshaft Position Sensor
1
11 5
G+
E10 E9
B–W
(*2)
2
L
1
B–R
B–R
12 4
NE+
E10 E9
(*2)
2
BR
L
(*1)
(*1)
6 17
NE–
E10 E9
(*2)
(*1)
E1
Crankshaft Position Sensor
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A03599
Author:
Date:
335
DI–101
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Perform troubleshooting of DTC 335 first. If notrouble is found, troubleshoot the following mechanical
system.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check resistance of crankshaft position sensor (See page IG–1).
G
G and NE Signal Waveforms
5 V/
Division
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
During cranking or idling, check between terminals G and G–,
NE and NE– of the ECM
HINT:
The correct waveforms are as shown.
NE
20 msec./Division (Idling)
5 V/
Division
G
NE
A01991
A01992
10 msec./Division (Idling)
A02359
NG
Replace crankshaft position sensor.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and
crankshaft position sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
336
DI–102
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Inspect sensor installation and teeth of crankshaft timing pulley
(See pages IG–10 and EM–15).
NG
Tighten the sensor. Replace crankshaft timing
pulley.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
337
DI–103
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI014–09
DTC
P0340
Camshaft Position Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Camshaft position sensor (G signal) consist of signal plate and pickup coil.
The G signal plate has one tooth on its outer circumference and is mounted on the exhaust camshaft.
When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the signal plate and the air gap on the pickup coil change,
causing fluctuations in the magnetic field and generating an electromotive force in the pickup coil.
The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34
signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the G signals
and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE signals.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
P0340
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine speed
600 rpm or more
Trouble Area
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Distributor
Di t ib t
Starter
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–100.
Author:
Date:
338
DI–104
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check resistance of camshaft position sensor (signal generator)
(See page IG–1).
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–100.
NG
Replace camshaft position sensor.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and camshaft
position sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Inspect sensor installation and tooth of camshaft timing pulley
(See pages IG–9 and EM–17).
NG
Tighten the sensor. Replace camshaft timing
pulley.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
339
DI–105
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI015–05
DTC
P0401
Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient
Detected
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
←
The EGR system recirculates exhaust gas, which is controlled to the proper quantity to suit the driving conditions, into the intake air mixture to slow down combustion, reduce the combustion temperature and reduce
NOx emissions. The amount of EGR is regulated by the EGR vacuum modulator according to the engine
load.
If even one of the following conditions is fulfilled, the VSV is
turned ON by a signal from the ECM.
Throttle Body
This results in atmospheric air acting on the EGR valve, closing
the EGR valve and shutting off the exhaust gas (EGR cut–off).
Under the following conditions, EGR is cut to maintain driveabilThrottle
ity.
Valve
ECM
Before engine is warmed up.
EGR Valve
During deceleration (throttle valve closed).
Light engine load (amount of intake air very small).
Engine idling.
VSV
Engine speed over 4,400 rpm.
High engine load (amount of intake air very large).
EGR
Exhaust Gas
Vacuum
Modulator
P25430
DTC No.
P0401
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up, intake manifold absolute pressure
is larger than value calculated by ECM while EGR system is
ON
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
EGR valve stuck closed
Open or short in VSV circuit for EGR
Vacuum or EGR hose disconnected
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
VSV for EGR open or close malfunction
ECM
Author:
Date:
340
DI–106
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
9
II3
J19
J/C
B−Y
B
B
B−Y
VSV
for EGR
2
1
P−B
B−Y
B
W−B
From
Battery
1
2A
EFI 5
3
2
2J
4
2F
2
1
7
2K
B−Y
B−W (*2)
6
II4
(*1)
15 23 EGR
E8 E9
(*2) (*1)
E01
From
Ignition SW
B−W (*2)
EFI Relay
7
E10 MREL
(*2)
Engine Room J/B No.2
EB
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A07551
Author:
Date:
341
DI–107
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
SYSTEM CHECK DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
60 ∼ 80 km/h
(38 ∼ 50 mph)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(6)
(3)
(2)
(7)
(4)
(5)
(1)
Warm up
3 ∼ 5 min.
2 min.
3 ∼ 5 min.
2 min.
Time
P20769
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Start and warm up the engine with all accessories switched OFF.
(3) Run the vehicle at 60 ∼ 80 km/h (38 ∼ 50 mph) for 3 min. or more.
(4) Idle the engine for about 2 min.
(5) Do steps (3) and (4) again.
(6) Stop at safe place and turn the ignition switch OFF.
(7) Do steps (2) to (5) again.
(8) Check the READINESS TESTS mode on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
If COMPL is displayed and the MIL does not light up, the system is normal.
If INCMPL is displayed and the MIL does not light up, run the vehicle again and check it.
HINT:
INCMPL is displayed when either condition (a) or (b) exists.
(a) The system check is incomplete.
(b) There is a malfunction in the system.
If there is a malfunction in the system, the MIL will light up after steps (2) to (5) above are done.
(2 trip detection logic)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction), P0106 (Manifold
Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem) and P0401 (Exhaust
Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient Detected) are output simultaneously, perform troubleshooting of
DTC P0105 first.
If DTC P0401 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient Detected) and P0402 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Excessive Detected) are output simultaneously, perform troubleshooting of DTC P0402
first.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
342
DI–108
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Check connection of the vacuum hose and EGR hose (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check VSV for EGR.
Air
Air
E
G
E
Air Filter
System: OFF
G
System: ON
A00407
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
CHECK:
Check operation of the VSV when it is operated by the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
EGR system is OFF:
Air from port E is flowing out through the air filter.
EGR system is ON:
Air from port E is flowing out port G.
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
3
Check operation of the VSV for EGR (See page SF–43).
NG
Replace VSV for EGR.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine room J/B No.2 and
ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
343
DI–109
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check EGR vacuum modulator (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR valve (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
7
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor (See page SF–53).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
344
DI–110
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
1
Check connection of vacuum hose and EGR hose (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check VSV for EGR.
ON
w/o Immobiliser
E9 Connector
EGR
ON
w/ Immobiliser
OFF
Air
E8 Connector
EGR
Air
OFF
ON
A03017
Air
Filter
VSV is ON
Air
OK
E
E
G
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E9 connector (w/o immobilizer) or E8 connector (w/ immobilizer) the ECM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check VSV function
(1) Connect between terminal EGR of the ECM connector and body ground (ON).
(2) Disconnect between terminal EGR of the ECM connector and body ground (ON).
OK:
(1) VSV is ON:
Air from port E is flowing out through the air filter.
(2) VSV is OFF:
Air from port E is flowing out port G.
Go to step 4.
G
VSV is OFF
A03418
NG
Author:
Date:
345
DI–111
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check operation of VSV for EGR (See page SF–43).
NG
Replace VSV for EGR.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine room J/B No.2 and
ECM (See page IN–31).
4
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check EGR vacuum modulator (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR valve (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
346
DI–112
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor (See page SF–53).
NG
Repair and replace.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
347
DI–113
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI016–04
DTC
P0402
Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Excessive
Detected
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0401 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient Detected) on page DI–105.
DTC No.
P0402
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
After engine is warmed up, conditions (a) and (b) continue:
(a) Intake manifold absolute pressure is larger than value calculated by ECM while EGR system is ON
(b) Misfiring is detected during idling
(2 trip detection logic)
EGR valve stuck open
Vacuum or EGR hose is connected to wrong post
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0401 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient Detected) on DI–105.
SYSTEM CHECK DRIVING PATTEM
Refer to DTC P0401 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient Detected) on DI–105.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0105 (Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction), P0106 (Manifold
Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem) and P0402 (Exhaust
Gas Recirculation Flow Excessive Detected) are output simultaneously, perform troubleshooting of
DTC P0105 first.
If DTC P0401 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient Detected) and P0402 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Excessive Detected) are output simultaneously, perform troubleshooting of DTC P0402
first.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check connection of vacuum hose and EGR hose (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
348
DI–114
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check EGR valve (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check VSV for EGR*.
*: If you have TOYOTA hand–held tester, see page DI–105, step 2.
If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, see page DI–105, step 2.
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
4
Check operation of VSV for EGR (See page SF–43).
NG
Replace VSV for EGR.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine room J/B No.2 and
ECM (See page IN–31).
5
Check EGR system (See page EC–12.)
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
349
DI–115
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check EGR vacuum modulator (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
7
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor (See page SF–53).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
350
DI–116
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1JX–03
DTC
P0420
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Except California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM compares the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor located before the catalyst with the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor located behind the catalyst to determine whether or not catalyst performance has deteriorated.
Air–fuel ratio feedback compensation keeps the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor before the catalyst
repeatedly changing back and forth from rich to lean.
If the catalyst is functioning normally, the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor behind the catalyst switches
back and forth between rich and lean much more slowly than the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor
before the catalyst.
But when both waveforms change at a similar rate, it indicates that catalyst performance has deteriorated.
Waveform of Heated Oxygen
Sensor before Catalyst
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of Heated Oxygen
Sensor behind Catalyst
FI7081
DTC No.
P0420
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine and catalyst are warmed up, and while vehicle is
driven within set vehicle and engine speed range, waveforms
of heated oxygen sensors (bank 1 sensor 1, 2) have same
amplitude (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
Heated oxygen sensor
Author:
Date:
351
DI–117
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
CONFIRMATION ENGINE RACING PATTERN
Engine Speed
(c)
2,500 ∼ 3,000 rpm
(b)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(d)
(a)
3 min. or so
Warmed up
Check
Time
FI7132
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3, or connect the probe of the oscilloscope between
terminals OX1, OX2 and E1 of the ECM connector.
Start engine and warm it up with all accessories switched OFF until water temp. is stable.
Race the engine at 2,500 ∼ 3,000 rpm for about 3 min.
After confirming that the waveforms of the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1 (OX1)), oscillate
around 0.5 V during feedback to the ECM, check the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor (bank
1 sensor 2 (OX2)).
OX Signal Waveform (Oscilloscope)
1.0 V
HINT:
0V
200 msec. /Division
If there is a malfunction in the system, the waveform of the
heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2 (OX2)) is almost
the same as that of the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1
sensor 1 (OX1)) on the left.
There are some cases where, even though a malfunction
exists, the MIL may either light up or not light up.
FI6514
Author:
Date:
352
DI–118
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0420) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) (See page DI–66).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
4
Check heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) (See page DI–77).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace three–way catalytic converter.
Author:
Date:
353
DI–119
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1JY–03
DTC
P0420
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM observes the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor located behind the catalyst to determine
whether the catalyst performance has deteriorated.
If the catalyst is functioning normally, the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor located behind the catalyst
switches back and forth between rich and lean much more slowly.
When the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor located behind the catalyst alternates flutteringly between
rich and lean, it indicates that catalyst performance has deteriorated.
Waveform of
A/F Sensor
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of Heated Oxygen
Sensor behind Catalyst
Abnormal Catalyst
A00357
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0420
After engine and catalyst are warmed up, and while vehicle is
driven within set vehicle and engine speed range, waveform of
heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) alternates flutteringly
between rich and lean
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
Author:
Date:
354
DI–120
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
CONFIRMATION ENGINE RACING PATTERN
Engine Speed
(c)
(d)
3,000 rpm
2,000 rpm
Idling
IG SW OFF
(b)
(a)
Time
Warmed up
3 min. or so
2 sec. 2 sec.
Check
A00479
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Start the engine and warm it up with all accessories switched OFF until water temp. is stable.
Race the engine at 2,500 ∼ 3,000 rpm for about 3 min.
When racing the engine at 3,000 rpm for 2 sec. and 2,000 rpm for 2 sec. alternately, check the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0420) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
355
DI–121
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check A/F sensor (See page DI–66).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
4
Check heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) (See page DI–77).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace three–way catalytic converter.
Author:
Date:
356
DI–122
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1JZ–04
DTC
P0440
Evaporative Emission Control System
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor are used to detect abnormalities in the evaporative emission control system.
The ECM decides whether there is an abnormality in the evaporative emission control system based on the
vapor pressure sensor signal.
DTC P0440 is recorded by the ECM when evaporative emissions leak from the components within the dotted
line in fig. 1 below, or when the vapor pressure sensor malfunctions.
ECM
fig.1
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
(6)
(7)
VSV for
EVAP
(1)
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Over Fill
(2) Check Valve
(8)
(9)
(4)
(5)
(3)
Fuel Tank
Charcoal Canister
A06549
DTC No.
P0440
DTC Detecting Condition
Fuel tank pressure is atmospheric pressure after vehicle is
driven for 20 min. (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Vapor pressure sensor
Fuel tank cap incorrectly installed
Fuel tank cap cracked or damaged
Vacuum hose cracked, holed, blocked, damaged
or disconnected ((1) or (2) in fig. 1)
Hose or tube cracked, holed, damaged or loose seal
((3) in fig. 1)
Fuel tank cracked, holed or damaged
Charcoal canister cracked, holed or damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracked or damaged
Author:
Date:
357
DI–123
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Vapor Pressure Sensor
3
Y
2
P
1
E
6
ID1
1
J28
J27
5
II4
PTNK
E2
V
3
22
E9
E9
(*2)
(*1)
16
8
E8
E8
(*2)
(*1)
EVP
TPC
E01
E01
Engine Room J/B No.2
1
From
Battery
J27
2A
4
W–B
J27
2
V
5V
B–Y
J/C
B
(*1)
VC
E1
VSV for Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
B–Y
B
1
ID1
2
(*2)
9
V–W
1
V
7
E8
E8
VSV
for EVAP
B
8
E8
BR
B–Y
B–Y
J/C
E
3
B–Y
B
E8
P
II2
J19
J/C
II3
10
8
II4
BR
ID1
1
Y
II4
P
2
BR
7
Y
ID1
9
B–Y
B–Y
5
ID1
2F
EFI 5
3
2
1
2
2J
7
2K
(*2)
B–W
6
II4
(*2)
B–W
7
E10
MREL
(*2)
EFI Relay
B–R (*1)
EB
From
Ignition SW
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A07552
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0441 (Evaporative Emission Control System Incorrect Purge Flow), P0446 (Evaporative
Emission Control System Vent Control Malfunction), P0450 (Evaporative Emission Control System
Pressure Sensor Malfunction) or P0451 is output after DTC P0440 (Evaporative Emission Control System Malfunction), first troubleshoot DTC P0441, P0446, P0450 or P0451. If no malfunction is detected,
troubleshoot DTC P0440 next.
Ask the customer whether, after the MIL came on, the customer found the fuel tank cap loose and tightened it. Also ask the customer whether the fuel tank cap was loose when refuelling. If the fuel tank cap
was not loose, it was the cause of the DTC. If the fuel tank cap was not loose or if the customer was
not sure if it was loose, troubleshoot according to the following procedure.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
When the ENGINE RUN TIME in the freeze frame data is less than 200 seconds, carefully check the
VSV for EVAP, charcoal canister and vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
358
DI–124
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check whether hose close to fuel tank have been modified, and check whether
there are signs of any accident near the fuel tank or charcoal canister.
CHECK:
Check for cracks, deformation and loose connection of the following parts.
Fuel tank
Charcoal canister
Fuel tank filler pipe
Hoses and tubes around fuel tank and charcoal
canister
A01653
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check that fuel tank cap is TOYOTA genuine parts.
NG
Replace to TOYOTA genuine parts.
OK
3
Check that fuel tank cap is correctly installed.
NG
Correctly install fuel tank cap.
OK
4
Check fuel tank cap (See page EC–6).
NG
Replace fuel tank cap.
OK
Author:
Date:
359
DI–125
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check filler neck for damage.
PREPARATION:
Remove the fuel tank cap.
CHECK:
Visually check the filler neck for damage.
NG
Replace filler neck.
OK
6
Check vacuum hoses between vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure sensor and charcoal canister.
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole and damage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
7
Check hose and tube between fuel tank and charcoal canister.
CHECK:
(a) Check for proper connection of the fuel tank and fuel evap pipe, fuel evap pipe and fuel tube under
the floor, fuel tube under the floor and charcoal canister.
(b) Check the hose and tube for cracks, hole and damage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
360
DI–126
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check charcoal canister (See page EC–6).
NG
Replace charcoal canister.
OK
9
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
CHECK:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
E2
(–)
VC
(+)
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
w/ Immobiliser
A03008
E2
(–)
VC
(+)
A03419
OK
Author:
Date:
361
DI–127
DIAGNOSTICS
10
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connector.
ON
w/o Immobiliser
E2 (–)
PTNK (+)
w/ Immobiliser
PTNK (+)
E2 (–)
(1)
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of the ECM
connector.
(1) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor.
(2) Using the MITYVAC (Hand–Held Vacuum Pump),
apply vacuum 4.0 kPa (30 mmHg, 1.18 in.Hg) to the
vapor pressure sensor.
NOTICE:
The vacuum applied to the vapor pressure sensor must be
less than 66.7 kPa (500 mmHg, 19.7 in.Hg).
OK:
(1) Voltage: 2.9 ∼ 3.7 V
(2) Voltage: 0.5 V or less
(2)
OK
A03018
Go to step 12.
Vacuum
A03420
NG
11
Check for open and short in harness and connector between vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
362
DI–128
DIAGNOSTICS
12
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check fuel tank and fuel tank over fill check valve for cracks and damage
(See page EC–6).
NG
Replace fuel tank or fuel tank over fill check
valve.
OK
It is likely that vehicle user did not properly close fuel tank cap. Please explain to customer how
to properly install fuel tank cap.
Author:
Date:
363
DI–129
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI019–10
DTC
P0441
Evaporative Emission Control System
Incorrect Purge Flow
DTC
P0446
Evaporative Emission Control System Vent
Control Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor are used to detect abnormalities in the evaporative emission control system.
The ECM decides whether there is an abnormality in the evaporative emission control system based on the
vapor pressure sensor signal.
DTCs P0441 and P0446 are recorded by the ECM when evaporative emissions leak from the components
within the dotted line in fig. 1 below, or when there is a malfunction in either the VSV for EVAP, the VSV for
vapor pressure sensor, or in the vapor pressure sensor itself.
ECM
fig.1
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
(7)
VSV for
EVAP
(6)
(1)
(4)
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
(2)
(5)
Fuel Tank Over
Fill Check Valve
(8)
(9)
(3)
Charcoal Canister
Fuel Tank
A06550
Author:
Date:
364
DI–130
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Pressure in the charcoal canister does not drop during purge
control
(2 trip detection logic)
P0441
During purge cut–off, pressure in charcoal canister is very low
compared with atmospheric pressure
(2 trip detection logic)
When VSV for vapor pressure sensor is OFF, ECM judges that
there is no continuity between vapor pressure sensor and
charcoal canister
(2 trip detection logic)
P0446
When VSV for vapor pressure sensor is ON, ECM judges that
there is no continuity between vapor pressure sensor and fuel
tank
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in VSV circuit for vapor pressure sensor
VSV for vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in VSV circuit for EVAP
VSV for EVAP
Vacuum hose cracks,
cracks hole,
hole blocked,
blocked damaged or
disconnected ((1), (4), (5) holed (6) and (7) in fig. 1)
Charcoal canister cracked, holed or damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracked or damaged
After purge cut off operates, pressure in charcoal canister is
maintained at atmospheric pressure
(2 trip detection logic)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0440 (Evaporative Emission Control System Malfunction) on page DI–122.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
HINT:
If DTC P0441 (Evaporative Emission Control System Incorrect Purge Flow), P0446 (Evaporative
Emission Control System Vent Control Malfunction), P0450 (Evaporative Emission Control System
Pressure Sensor Malfunction) or P0451 is output after DTC P0440 (Evaporative Emission Control System Malfunction), first troubleshoot DTC P0441, P0446, P0450 or P0451. If no malfunction is detected,
troubleshoot DTC P0440 next.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
When the ENGINE RUN TIME in the freeze frame data is less than 200 seconds, carefully check the
VSV for EVAP, charcoal canister and vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
365
DI–131
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check VSV connector for EVAP, VSV connector for vapor pressure sensor and
vapor pressure sensor connector for looseness and disconnection.
NG
Repair or connect VSV or sensor connector.
OK
2
Check vacuum hoses (1), (4), (5), (6), (7), (8) and (9) on page DI–122).
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole, damage and blockage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–122, step 9).
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
4
Check voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–122, step 10).
OK
Go to step 6.
NG
Author:
Date:
366
DI–132
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace vapor pressure sensor.
6
Check purge flow.
VSV is ON
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(c) Disconnect the vacuum hose for the VSV for EVAP from
the charcoal canister.
(d) Start the engine.
CHECK:
When the VSV for EVAP is operated by the TOYOTA hand–
held tester, check whether the disconnected hose applies suction to your finger.
OK:
VSV is ON:
Disconnected hose applies suction to your finger.
VSV is OFF:
Disconnected hose applies no suction to your finger.
To
Throttle
Body
Suction
VSV is OFF
To
Throttle
Body
No Suction
A03278
A03279
OK
Go to step 10.
A03456
NG
Author:
Date:
367
DI–133
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check vacuum hose between intake manifold and VSV for EVAP, and VSV for
EVAP and charcoal canister.
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole, damage and blockage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
8
Check operation of VSV for EVAP (See page SF–45).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
Replace VSV, charcoal canister and then clean the vacuum hose between throttle body and VSV
for EVAP, and VSV for EVAP and charcoal canister.
9
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and VSV for EVAP, and VSV for EVAP and ECM
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
368
DI–134
DIAGNOSTICS
10
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check the VSV for vapor pressure sensor.
ON
E
F
VSV is ON
E
G
F
G
VSV is OFF
A00472
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
CHECK:
Check the VSV operation when it is operated by TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
(1) VSV is ON:
Air from port E is flowing out through port F.
(2) VSV is OFF:
Air from port E is flowing out through port G.
OK
Go to step 13.
NG
11
Check operation of VSV for vapor pressure sensor (See page SF–47).
OK
Gp to step 12.
NG
Replace VSV charcoal canister, and then clean the vacuum hoses between charcoal canister and
VSV for vapor pressure sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure sensor and vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
369
DI–135
DIAGNOSTICS
12
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and VSV for vapor pressure sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
13
When VSV connector for vapor pressure sensor is disconnected and VSV for
EVAP is ON, measure voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connector.
VSV Connector for
Vapor Pressure Sensor
w/o Immobiliser
PTNK (+)
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Disconnect the VSV connector for the vapor pressure
sensor.
(d) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(e) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of the ECM
connector using the TOYOTA hand–held tester when the VSV
for the EVAP is ON.
OK:
Voltage: 2.0 V or less
E2 (–)
w/ Immobiliser
OK
A03280
A03018
PTNK (+)
Go to step 15.
E2 (–)
A03421
NG
Author:
Date:
370
DI–136
DIAGNOSTICS
14
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check vacuum hoses between charcoal canister and VSV for vapor pressure
sensor, and vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor.
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole, damage and blockage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
15
Engine
Check the charcoal canister.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Remove the fuel tank cap.
(d) Disconnect the VSV connector for the vapor pressure
sensor.
(e) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(f)
Start the engine.
(g) The VSV for the EVAP is ON by the TOYOTA hand–held
tester and remains on for 5 sec.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of the ECM
connector 5 sec. after switching the VSV for the EVAP from ON
to OFF.
OK:
Voltage: 2.5 V or less
Start
Stop
VSV for Vapor ON
Pressure
Sensor
OFF
ON
VSV for
EVAP
OFF
5 sec.
5 sec.
w/o Immobiliser
PTNK
(+)
E2
(–)
w/ Immobiliser
NG
A03018
PTNK (+)
Replace charcoal canister.
E2(–)
A03422
OK
Author:
Date:
371
DI–137
DIAGNOSTICS
16
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Remove charcoal canister and check it (See page EC–5)
NG
Replace charcoal canister.
OK
17
Check fuel tank over fill check valve (See page EC–6).
NG
Replace fuel tank over fill check valve or fuel
tank.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
HINT:
If DTC P0441 (Evaporative Emission Control System Incorrect Purge Flow), P0446 (Evaporative Emission
Control System Vent Control Malfunction) or P0450 (Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure Sensor
Malfunction) is output after DTC P0440 (Evaporative Emission Control System Malfunction), first troubleshoot DTC P0441, P0446 or P0450. If no malfunction is detected, troubleshoot DTC P0440 next.
1
Check VSV connector for EVAP, VSV connector for vapor pressure sensor and
vapor pressure sensor connector for looseness and disconnection.
NG
Repair or connect VSV or sensor connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
372
DI–138
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check vacuum hoses ((1), (4), (5), (6), (7), (8) and (9) on page DI–122).
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole, damage and blockage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–122, step 9).
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
4
Check voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–122, step 10).
OK
Go to step 6.
NG
5
Check for open and short in harness and connector between vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
373
DI–139
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check VSV for EVAP.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check VSV function.
(1) Connect between terminal EVP of the ECM connector and body ground (ON).
(2) Disconnect between terminal EVP of the ECM connector and body ground (OFF).
OK:
(1) VSV is ON:
Air from port E is flowing out through port F.
(2) VSV is OFF:
Air does not flow from port E to port F.
ON
w/o Immobiliser
EVP
ON
OFF
w/ Immobiliser
E
EVP
ON
OFF
OK
E
F
A03019
Go to step 8.
E
F
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
A03423
NG
7
Check operator of VSV for EVAP (See page SF–45).
NG
Go to step 9.
OK
Replace VSV and clean vacuum hoses between throttle body and VSV for EVAP, and VSV for
EVAP and charcoal canister, and then check charcoal canister.
Author:
Date:
374
DI–140
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and VSV for EVAP, and VSV for EVAP and ECM (See page IN–31)
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
9
Check VSV for vapor pressure sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
(a) Connect between terminal TPC of the ECM connector
and body ground (ON).
(b) Disconnect between terminal TPC of the ECM connector
and body ground (OFF).
OK:
(1) VSV is ON:
Air from port E is flowing out through port F.
(2) VSV is OFF:
Air from port E is flowing out through port G.
ON
w/o Immobiliser
OFF
TPC
ON
w/ Immobiliser
OFF
TPC
ON
E
F
E
G
VSV is ON
A03020
F
G
VSV is OFF
A03424
OK
Check and replace charcoal canister
(See page EC–6).
NG
Author:
Date:
375
DI–141
DIAGNOSTICS
10
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check operation of VSV for vapor pressure sensor (See page SF–47).
NG
Go to step 11.
OK
Replace VSV and clean vacuum hoses between charcoal canister and VSV for vapor pressure
sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure sensor and vapor pressure sensor, and then check the charcoal canister.
11
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and VSV for vapor pressure sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
12
Check fuel tank over fill check valve (See page EC–6).
NG
Replace fuel tank over fill check valve or fuel
tank.
OK
Check and replace charcoal canister
(See page EC–6).
Author:
Date:
376
DI–142
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1K0–04
DTC
P0450
Evaporative Emission Control System
Pressure Sensor Malfunction
DTC
P0451
Evaporative Emission Control System
Pressure Sensor Range/Performance
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor are used to detect abnormalities in the evaporative emission control system.
The ECM decides whether there is an abnormality in the evaporative emission control system based on the
vapor pressure sensor signal.
DTC P0450 is recorded by the ECM when the vapor pressure sensor malfunction.
ECM
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
VSV for
EVAP
Fuel Tank Over
Fill Check Valve
Charcoal Canister
Fuel Tank
A06551
Author:
Date:
377
DI–143
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0450
10 seconds or more after engine starting codition (a) or (b)
continues for 7 seconds or more:
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) vapor pressure sensor value < –4 kpa (–30 mmHg,
–1.0 in.Hg)
(b) Vapor pressure sensor value 2.1 kpa (–15 mmHg,
0.4 in.Hg)
P0451
Vapor pressure sensor output extremely changes under conditions of (a), (b) and (c):
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 0 km/h (0 mph)
(b) Engine speed: idling
(c) VSV for vapor pressure sensor is ON
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
Fuel
F l tank
t k over fill check
h k valve
l cracked
k d or damaged.
d
d
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0440 (Evaporative Emission Control System Malfunction) on page DI–122.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0441 (Evaporative Emission Control System Incorrect Purge Flow), P0446 (Evaporative
Emission Control System Vent Control Malfunction), P0450 (Evaporative Emission Control System
Pressure Sensor Malfunction) or P0451 is output after DTC P0440 (Evaporative Emission Control System Malfunction), first troubleshoot DTC P0441, P0446, P0450 or P0451. If no malfunction is detected,
troubleshoot DTC P0440 next.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
When the ENGINE RUN TIME in the freeze frame data is less than 200 seconds, carefully check the
VSV for EVAP, charcoal canister and vapor pressure sensor.
1
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–122, step 9).
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
Author:
Date:
378
DI–144
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–122, step 10 ).
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between the vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
379
DI–145
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01B–10
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft, which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear. After this signal is converted into a more precise
rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted
to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pluse signals.
4–Pulse
4–Pulse
No.1 Vehicle
Speed Sensor
Combination Meter
ECM
Transaxle
No.1 Vehicle Speed Sensor
A00414
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0500
During vehicle is being driven, no vehicle speed sensor signal
to ECM
(2 trip detection logic)
Combination meter
Open or short in No.1 vehicle speed sensor circuit
No.1 vehicle speed sensor
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Combination Meter
14
C9
5V
V–W
3
IG3
J15
J/C
V–W
V–W
B
B
8
E7
9
SPD
E7
(*2)
(*1)
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A03601
Author:
Date:
380
DI–146
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check operation of speedometer.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the speedmeter in the combination meter is normal.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
NG
Check speedometer circuit. See combination
meter troubleshooting (See page BE–2).
OK
Author:
Date:
381
DI–147
DIAGNOSTICS
2
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Shift the shift lever to neutral.
(c) Jack up one of the front wheels.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and
body ground when the wheel is turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage is generated intermittently.
ON
w/o Immobiliser
SP1
(+)
w/ Immobiliser
A03021
–
4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
SP1
(+)
0
Turn the wheel
A03425
NG
AT7809
Check and repair harness and connector
between combination meter and ECM.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
382
DI–148
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01C–05
DTC
P0505
Idle Control System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Intake Air
Chamber
Throttle Valve
From
Air
Cleaner
Signal
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is located on the throttle
body and intake air bypassing the throttle valve is directed to
the IAC valve through a passage.
In this way the intake air volume bypassing the throttle valve is
regulated, controlling the engine speed.
The ECM operates only the IAC valve to perform idle–up and
provide feedback for the target idling speed.
ECM
Valve
To Cylinder
IAC Valve
P01559
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble AreaTrouble Area
IAC valve is stuck or closed
Open or short in IAC valve circuit
Open or short in A/C switch circuit
Air intake (hose loose)
ECM
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from the target speed
(2 trip detection logic)
P0505
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
IAC Valve
J19
J/C
9
II3
W
B–Y
1
B–Y
B
2
B
B–Y
B–O
3
7
E9
10
E9
(*2)
(*1)
6
E9
9
E9
(*2)
(*1)
ISCO
ISCC
E01
E01
Engine Room J/B No.2
From
Battery
W–B
B
EB
1
2A
EFI 5
3
2
2J
4
2F
2
1
7
2K
B–W (*2)
6
II4
B–W (*2)
7
E10
MREL
(*2)
EFI Relay
B–R (*1)
From
Ignition SW
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
Author:
Date:
A07553
383
DI–149
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check idle speed.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Switch off all the accessories.
(c) Switch off the air conditioning.
(d) Shift the transmission into N or neutral position.
(e) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(f)
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
CHECK:
Check the difference of engine speed between the ones less than 5 sec. and more than 5 sec. after connecting terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
OK:
Difference of engine speed: More than 100 rpm
OK
Go to step 6.
NG
Author:
Date:
384
DI–150
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminals RSO, RSC of ECM connector and body ground.
w/o Immobiliser
A00416
E9 Connector
RSO(+)
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E9 connector of the ECM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals RSO, RSC of the ECM
connector and body ground,
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
RSC(+)
w/ Immobiliser
OK
Go to step 4.
E9 Connector
RSO(+)
RSC(+)
A03022
A03426
NG
3
Check IAC valve (See page SF–35).
NG
Replace IAC valve.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine room J/B No.2 and IAC valve,
and IAC valve and ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
385
DI–151
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check operation of IAC valve (See page SF–35).
NG
Repair or replace IAC valve.
OK
5
Check blockage of IAC valve and passage to bypass throttle valve.
NG
Repair or replace IAC valve.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
6
Check for A/C signal circuit (See page AC–84).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check air induction system
(See page SF–1).
Author:
Date:
386
DI–152
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01D–06
DTC
P1130
A/F Sensor Circuit Range/Performance
Malfunction (Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–61.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Voltage output* of A/F sensor remains at 3.8 V or more, or 2.8
V or less, during engine running after engine is warmed up (2
trip detection logic)
*: Output value changes at the inside of ECM only
P1130
Voltage output* of A/F sensor does not change from 3.30 V,
during engine running after engine is warmed up
(2 trip detection logic)
*: Output value changes at inside of ECM only
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
ECM
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
(2 trip detection logic)
HINT:
After confirming DTC P1130, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester to confirm voltage
output of A/F sensor (AFS B1 S1 / O2S B1 S1) from the CURRENT DATA.
The A/F sensor’s output voltage and the short−term fuel trim value can be read using the OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester.
The ECM controls the voltage of AF and AF terminals of ECM to the fixed voltage. Therefore, it
is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand−held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand−held tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–61.
Author:
Date:
387
DI–153
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
60 ∼ 120 km/h
(38 ∼ 75 mph)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(4)
(3)
(1)(2)
3 ∼ 5 min.
Time
A00364
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from normal mode to check mode (See page DI–3).
Start the engine and warm it up with all accessory switches OFF.
Drive the vehicle at 60 ∼ 120 km/h (38 ∼ 75 mph) and engine speed at 1,600 ∼ 3,200 rpm for 3
∼ 5 min.
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will light up during step (4).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction will not be possible.
If you do not have a TOYOTA hand–held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps
(3) and (4), then perform steps (3) and (4) again.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P1130) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
388
DI–154
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value for voltage output of A/F sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read voltage value of the A/F sensor on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester when
you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of AF terminal of ECM is 3.3 V fixed and AF terminal is 3.0 V fixed. Therefore, it is impossible
to check the A/F sensor output voltage at the terminals (AF/AF) of ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage Value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle valve
open and close
Not remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V)
Not remains at 3
3.8
8 V (* 0
0.76
76 V) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is below 2.8 V (* 0.56
V), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is above 3.8 V (* 0.76 V), it
is normally.
If output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V) even after performing all the above
conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be open.
If output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.8 V (* 0.76 V) or more, or 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less even
after performing all the above conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
389
DI–155
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (See page SF–59).
NG
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
5
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
Author:
Date:
390
DI–156
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check injector injection (See page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace A/F sensor.
9
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–152).
Go
10
Is there DTC P1130 being output again?
YES
Check and replace ECM.
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past?
NO
Check for intermittent problems.
YES
DTC P0125 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
391
DI–157
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01E–06
DTC
P1133
A/F Sensor Circuit Response Malfunction
(Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–61.
DTC No.
P1133
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
After engine is warmed up, and during vehicle driving at engine speed 1,600 rpm or more and vehicle speed 60 km/h (38
mph) or more, if response characteristic of A/F sensor becomes deteriorated
(2 trip detection logic)
A/F sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the, malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P1133) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
392
DI–158
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA nand–held teter, and read value for voltage
output of A/F sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read voltage value of the A/F sensor on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester when
you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of AF terminal of ECM is 3.3 V fixed and AF terminal is 3.0 V fixed. Therefore, it is impossible
to check the A/F sensor output voltage at the terminals (AF/AF) of ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage Value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle valve
open and close
Not remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V)
Not remains at 3
3.8
8 V (* 0
0.76
76 V) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is below 2.8 V (* 0.56
V), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is above 3.8 V (* 0.76 V), it
is normally.
If output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V) even after performing all the above
conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be open.
If output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.8 V (* 0.76 V) or more, or 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less even
after performing all the above conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
393
DI–159
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (See page SF–59).
NG
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
5
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
Author:
Date:
394
DI–160
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check injector injection (See page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace A/F sensor.
9
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–152).
Go
10
Is there DTC P1133 being output again?
YES
Check and replace ECM.
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past?
NO
Check for intermittent problems.
YES
DTC P1133 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
395
DI–161
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01F–05
DTC
P1135
A/F Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–61.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When heater operates, heater current exceeds 8 A
(2 trip detection logic)
P1135
Heater current of 0.25 A or less when heater operates
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor h
heater
t
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–61.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check voltage between terminal HTAF of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals HTAF of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
HTAF (+)
A00430
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Author:
Date:
396
DI–162
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (See page SF–59).
NG
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
Check and repair harness or connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and A/F sensor,
and A/F sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
397
DI–163
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01G–06
DTC
P1300
Igniter Circuit Malfunction No.1
DTC
P1310
Igniter Circuit Malfunction No.2
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the ignition timing, turns on Tr1 at a predetermined angle (°CA) before the desired
ignition timing and outputs and ignition signal (IGT) 1 to the igniter.
Since the width of the IGT signal is constant, the dwell angle control circuit in the igniter determines the time
the control circuit starts primary current flow to the ignition coil based on the engine rpm and ignition timing
one revolution ago, that is, the time the Tr2 turns on.
When it reaches the ignition timing, the ECM turns Tr1 off and outputs the IGT signal O.
This turns Tr2 off, interrupting the primary current flow and generating a high voltage in the secondary coil
which causes the spark plug to spark. Also, by the counter electromotive force generated when the primary
current is interrupted, the igniter sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) to the ECM. The ECM stops fuel
injection as a fail safe function when the IGF signal is not input to the ECM.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P1300
No IGF signal to ECM for 4 consecutive IGT1 signals during
engine running
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter to ECM
Ignition coil No.1 (Igniter No.1)
ECM
P1310
No IGF signal to ECM for 4 consecutive IGT2 signals during
engine running
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter to ECM
Ignition coil No.2 (Igniter No.2)
ECM
HINT:
Ignition coil No.1 is for cylinder No.1 and No.4, and ignition coil No.2 is for cylinder No.2 and No.3.
Author:
Date:
398
DI–164
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
IG Switch
7
B–R
6
W–R
13
5
1K
1B
B
2A
2L
4
Engine Room
J/B No.2
B–G
A
J/C
Battery
A
A BR
EC
(*2)
IGT1
Tr1
(*1)
3
Igniter
No.2
2
Tr2
Ignition Coil
No.2
W–R
3
Y–R
W–R
BR 4
J19
23 20
E9 E9
Spark Plug
1
BR
1 F4
MAIN FL
Tr2
5V
W–R
FL Block
Igniter
No.1
BR
B–R
1 F6
4
B
W–R
B
AM2
Ignition
Coil
No.1
B
2
B–R
B
1
J25
J/C
Instrument
Panel J/B
1
B–R
II3
5
Spark Plug
22 19
E9 E9
IGT2
17 3
E9 E9
IGF
(*2)
Tr1
(*1)
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A07122
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P1300 is displayed, check ignition coil No.1 circuit.
If DTC P1300 is displayed, check ignition coil No.2 circuit.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check for spark plug and spark of misifining cylinder (See page DI–89).
NG
Go to step 4.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector in IGF signal circuit between
ECM and ignition coils (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
399
DI–165
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Disconnect ignition coil connectors, and check voltage between terminal IGF of
ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the ignition coil connector.
(b) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal IGF of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
IGF
(+)
OK
Replace ignition coil.
w/ Immobiliser
A00417
A03023
IGF
(+)
A03427
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
4
Check for open and short in harness and connector in IGT1, 2 signal circuit between ECM and ignition coils (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
400
DI–166
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminals IGT1, 2 of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal IGT1, 2 of the ECM connector and body ground when the engine is cranked.
OK:
Voltage: More than 0.1 V and less than 4.5 V
START
w/o Immobiliser
IGT2 (+)
IGT1 (+)
w/ Immobiliser
IGT2 (+)
A03024
IGT1 (+)
A03428
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
During idling, check waveform between terminals IGT1, 2 and
IGT Signal Waveform
2 V/
E1 of the ECM.
Division
HINT:
IGT
The correct waveforms are as shown.
0V
IGF
0V
10 msec./Division (Idling)
FI6680
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Author:
Date:
401
DI–167
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Disconnect ignition coil connectors, and check voltage between terminals IGT1,
2 of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the ignition coil connectors.
(b) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals IGT1, 2 of the ECM connector and body ground when the engine is cranked.
OK:
Voltage: More than 0.1 V and less than 5 V
START
w/o Immobiliser
IGT2 (+)
IGT1 (+)
OK
Replace ignition coil.
w/ Immobiliser
IGT2 (+)
A03024
IGT1 (+)
A03428
NG
7
Check ignition coil with igniter power source circuit.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the ignition coil connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of the ignition coil with the
igniter connector and body ground when the ignition switch is
turned to ON and STA position.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
START
1 (+)
BE6653
A01761
A01861
NG
Repair ignition coil with igniter power source
circuit.
OK
Author:
Date:
402
DI–168
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ignition switch and
ignition coils (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
9
Check ignition coil (See page IG–5).
NG
Replace ignition coil.
OK
10
Check EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) (See page SF–40).
NG
Replace EFI main relay.
OK
Replace igniter.
Author:
Date:
403
DI–169
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI1K1–02
DTC
P1335
Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit
Malfunction (During engine running)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–100.
DTC No.
P1335
DTC Detecting Condition
If conditions (a) through (c) are met:
(a) NE 1,000 rpm
(b) NE signal is not detected for over 50 m sec.
(c) Not during cranking
Trouble Area
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–100.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–100.
Author:
Date:
404
DI–170
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01H–07
DTC
P1520
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction (Only
for A/T)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This signal is used to detect when the brakes have been applied. The STP signal voltage is the same as
the voltage supplied to the stop lights.
The STP signal is used mainly to control the fuel cut–off engine speed. (The fuel cut–off engine speed is
reduced slightly when the vehicle is braking.)
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Stop light switch does not turn off even once vehicle is driven
(2 trip detection logic)
P1520
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
Stop Light
Switch
W
G–W
2
1
5
1R
Light
Failure
Sensor
1 F4
R
B–R
MAIN
FL
W–B
FL Block
ALT
1 F9 2 F9
A
J27
C
J28
G–W
9
4
E7
E7
(*2)
(*1)
STP
Battery
BL
J40
J/C
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
7
1
2
1
A
2
High
Mount
Stop
Light
W–B
A
G–R
2
Stop
Light
(RH)
5 W–B
2
Stop
Light
(LH)
5
W–B
Instrument
Panel J/B
4 1B
B–R
G–W
ECM
2 1S
G–W
STOP
7 1C
4
1R
J27
J/C
BP
A03604
Author:
Date:
405
DI–171
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check operation of stop light.
PREPARATION:
Check if the stop lights go on and off normally when the brake pedal is operated and released.
NG
Check and repair stop light circuit
(See page BE–37).
OK
Author:
Date:
406
DI–172
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check STP signal.
ON
Brake Pedal
Depressed
Brake Pedal
Released
ON
When using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the STP signal on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Brake pedal is depressed: STP ... ON
Brake pedal is released:
STP ... OFF
w/o Immobiliser
When not using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check voltage between terminal STP of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
STP (+)
w/ Immobiliser
Brake pedal
Voltage
Depressed
7.5 ∼ 14 V
Released
Below 1.5 V
STP (+)
A03025
A03429
OK
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
NG
3
Check harness and connector between ECM and stop light switch
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
407
DI–173
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01I–10
DTC
P1600
ECM BATT Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied to terminal BATT of the ECM even when the ignition switch is OFF for
use by the DTC memory and air–fuel ratio adaptive control value memory, etc.
DTC No.
P1600
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open in back up power source circuit
ECM
Open in back up power source circuit
HINT:
If DTC P1600 appear, the ECM does not store another DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room J/B No.2
B–G
1
F4
1
F6
B
1
2A
EFI
8
2J
B–Y
FL Block
MAIN FL
2
E7
1
E7
(*2)
(*1)
BATT
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
Battery
A03605
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
408
DI–174
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminal BATT of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal BATT of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage 9 ∼ 14 V
LOCK
w/o Immobiliser
BATT (+)
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
w/ Immobiliser
BATT (+)
A03026
A03448
NG
2
Check EFI fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room J/B No.2.
CHECK:
Check continuity of the EFI fuse.
OK:
Continuity
Engine Room J/B No.2
NG
EFI Fuse
A00356
Check for short in all harness and components
connected to EFI fuse.
OK
Check and repair harness or connector
between battery and EFI fuse, and EFI fuse
and ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
409
DI–175
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01J–05
DTC
P1780
Park/Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
(Only for A/T)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it goes on
terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay thus the terminal NSW voltage
becomes 0V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the park/neutral position switch goes off,
so the voltage of ECM. Terminal NSW becomes battery positive voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal
power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air–fuel ratio correction
and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
2 or more switches are ON simultaneously for P, R, N, D, 2
and L positions
(2 trip detection logic)
P1780
When driving under conditions (a) and (b) for 30 sec. or more
park/neutral position switch is ON (N position):
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 80 km/h (50 mph) or more
(b) Engine speed: 2,000 ∼ 5,000 rpm
Trouble Area
Short
Sh t in
i park/neutral
k/
t l position
iti switch
it h circuit
i it
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P1780, use the TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the PNP switch signal from the
CURRENT DATA.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1780 on page DI–424.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Refer to DTC P1780 on DI–424.
Author:
Date:
410
DI–176
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01K–10
Starter Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, the intake air flow is slow, so fuel vaporization is poor. A rich mixture is therefore
necessary in order to achieve good startability. While the engine is being cranked, the battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM. The starter signal is mainly used to increase the fuel injection
volume for the starting injection control and after–start injection control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument
Panel J/B
IG Switch
R
8
4
1K
3
1J
STARTER
5
7
1K
W–R
J29
J/C
B–W
B
(A/T)
B–W
B
B
5
1B
Park/Neutral
Position Switch 10
5
6
II2
B–W
GR
11
II2
(A/T)
1
B–O (A/T,*2)
GR (A/T,*1)
C J/C B
J8
J7
GR (*1)
B–O (*2)
B–W (M/T)
W–R
ECM
2 (M/T)
Clutch Start
Switch
GR (*1)
B–O (*2)
11
STA
E7
B J7
E1
GR (*1)
B–O (*2)
B
B
1
2A
3
2B
11 2J
MAIN
FL
1 Block 1
F4
F6
AM2
4 2L
5
1
Engine Room
J/B No. 2
ST
Relay
3
2
W–B
B–G
5 2D 9 2K
A
MAIN
FL
B–R
1
S1
1
S2
B–R
J11
J/C
Starter
Battery
*1: TMC Made
*2: TMMK Made
IG
A03606
Author:
Date:
411
DI–177
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
This diagnostic chart is based on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the engine is not
cranked, proceed to the problem symptoms table on page DI–28.
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester, and check STA signal.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read STA signal on the TOYOTA hand–held tester while the starter operates.
OK:
Ignition Switch Position
ON
START
STA signal
OFF
ON
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–28).
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and starter relay
(Marking: ST) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
412
DI–178
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
HINT:
This diagnostic chart is based on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the engine is not
cranked, proceed to the problem symptoms table on page DI–28.
1
Check voltage between terminal STA of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal STA of the ECM connector
and body ground, during the engine cranking.
OK:
Voltage: 6 V or more
START
w/o Immobiliser
STA (+)
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–28).
w/ Immobiliser
STA (+)
A03027
A03449
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and starter relay
(Marking: ST) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
413
DI–179
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01L–05
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery positive voltage is applied to the coil, closing the contacts of
the EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and supplying power to terminal +B of the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
B–Y
B
J27
J/C
B
J28
12
+B
E7
B–Y
B–W (*1)
B–R (*2)
2
4
2F
W–B
EB
Instrument
Panel J/B
3 1K
6
IG
Switch
14 24
E9 E9 E1
(*2) (*1)
4 2L
7
B
7
E10 MREL
W–R
BR
1 2A
5
1B
5 1K
AM2
5
EFI
Relay
B–Y (*1)
IGN
1
6 II4
7 1W
B–R
3
Engine
Room
J/B No.2
W–R
7 2K
EFI
2 2J
1 F6
FL
Block
A
1 F4
J23
J/C
A
B–G
Battery
BR
MAIN
FL
*1: w/ Immobiliser
*2: w/o Immobiliser
EC
A07554
Author:
Date:
414
DI–180
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals + B and E1 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals + B and E1 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
+B (+)
E1
(–)
w/ Immobiliser
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
Problem symptoms table (See page DI–28).
+B (+)
E1
(–)
BE6653
A03028
A03709
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal E1 of ECM and body
ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) (See page SF–40).
NG
Replace EFI main relay.
OK
Author:
Date:
415
DI–181
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check EFI fuse (See page DI–173, step 2).
NG
Check for short in all harness and components
connected to EFI fuse.
OK
5
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI)
and battery, and EFI main relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
6
Check IGN fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument panel J/B.
CHECK:
Check continuity of the IGN fuse.
OK:
Continuity
IGN Fuse
Instrument Panel J/B
NG
A00355
Check for short in all harness and components
connected to IGN fuse.
OK
Author:
Date:
416
DI–182
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check ignition switch (See page BE–14).
NG
Replace ignition switch.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between IG switch and EFI main relay, and EFI main
relay and body ground (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
417
DI–183
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01M–05
Fuel Pump Control Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
In the diagram below, when the engine is cranked, current flows from terminal ST of the ignition switch to
the starter relay coil and also current flows to terminal STA of ECM (STA signal).
When the STA signal and NE signal are input to the ECM, Tr is turned ON, current flows to coil of the circuit
opening relay, the relay switches on, power is supplied to the fuel pump and the fuel pump operates.
While the NE signal is generated (engine running), the ECM keeps Tr ON (circuit opening relay ON) and the
fuel pump also keeps operating.
EFI Relay
EFI
IG Switch
IGN
AM2
CIR OPN Relay
Fuel Pump
ECM
Park/Neutral Position Switch
(Clutch Start Switch)
FC
Tr
ST STARTER
ST Relay
MAIN
FL
MAIN
(STA Signal)
STA
(NE Signal)
NE
Starter
Battery
A00325
Author:
Date:
418
7
IK1
B–R (*4)
B–R
B–W (*1)
Engine Room J/B No.2
Instrument Panel J/B
IG Switch
3
7
IGN
7
B–R
1K
1W
6
B–R (*4)
B–W
B
5
3
2
1
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
GR
B–W
(A/T)
6
5
Clutch Start
Switch
Date:
B–W
(M/T)
B–R
MAIN
FL
1
5
2D
11
2J
1
B–R
GR (*2)
B–O (*3)
5 EB1 EB1 4
G–R
10
II2
GR (*2)
B–O (*3)
C
J7
B
*1: w/ Immobiliser
*2: TMC Made
*3: TMMK Made
*4: w/o Immobiliser
7
E10 MREL
(*1)
14 FC
E7
J8
J/C
E01
7
ID1
GR (*2)
B–O (*3)
2 (M/T)
1
S1
4
1
S2 7
Fuel
Pump
5
Starter
Battery
ECM
W–B
BL
J40
J/C
A
ENGINE (5S–FE)
II2
3
–
11
B
2
CIR
OPN
Relay
L–B
IG
B
5
DIAGNOSTICS
J29
J/C
1
L–B
B–W
B–G
Author:
A
MAIN
9
2K
W–B
1
1
ST Relay
II4
L–B
B
1
G–R
B
EFI
1
2A
3
2B
B
B
EB
6
B–R
(*1)
4
2L
W–R
W–B
J11
J/C
2
EFI Relay
AM2
1
1
F6
F4
FL Block
1
10
2C
4
W–B
2F
B–W
W–R
3
Engine Room R/B
No.1
4 STARTER 3
1J
1K
5
5
1K
1B
R
8
7
2K
5
DI–184
WIRING DIAGRAM
B–R (*1)
A07555
419
DI–185
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester, and check operation of fuel pump
(See page DI–3).
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–28).
NG
2
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–179).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) (See page SF–41).
NG
Replace circuit opening relay.
OK
Author:
Date:
420
DI–186
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal FC of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
w/o Immobiliser
FC (+)
w/ Immobiliser
FC (+)
A03029
A03450
OK
Go to step 5.
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay, and circuit opening relay and
circuit opening relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
5
Check fuel pump (See page SF–6).
NG
Repair or replace fuel pump.
OK
Author:
Date:
421
DI–187
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) and fuel pump, and fuel pump and body ground
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
1
Check operation of fuel pump.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
(a) Connect between terminal FC of the ECM connector and
body ground.
(b) Check for fuel pressure in the fuel inlet hose when it is
pinched off.
OK:
There is pressure in fuel inlet hose.
HINT:
At this time, you will hear a fuel return flowing noise.
ON
w/o Immobiliser
FC
OFF
w/ Immobiliser
OFF
ON
FC
ON
OK
Fuel Inlet Hose
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–28).
A03030
A03451
NG
Author:
Date:
422
DI–188
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–179).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) (See page SF–41).
NG
Replace circuit opening relay.
OK
4
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM connector and body ground
(See page DI–183, step 4).
OK
Go to step 5.
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay and circuit opening relay, and
circuit opening relay and ECM (See page IN–31).
5
Check fuel pump (See page SF–6).
NG
Repair or replace fuel pump.
OK
Author:
Date:
423
DI–189
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) and fuel pump, and fuel pump and body ground
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
424
DI–190
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01N–04
A/C Compressor Lock Sencor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor sends 1 pulse par engine revolution to the ECM. If the number ratio of the compressor speed
divided by the engine speed is smaller than a predetermined value, the ECM turns the compressor off. And,
the indicator flashes at about 1 second intervals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
9
W–L
IK2
10
W–L
W–L
II3
1
A/C Compressor
Lock Sensor
2
10
BR
BR
IK2
J8
J/C
6
BR
B
J23
J/C
II3
B
BR
BR
A
A
BR
A
EC
19
18
E9
E9
(*2)
(*1)
24
14
E9
E9
(*2)
(*1)
LOCK IN
E1
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A03610
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check compressor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Check the compressor drive belt tension (See page AC–16).
(b) Check if the compressor does not lock during operation with the engine started and blower switch and
A/C switch ON.
NG
Adjust drive belt tension or repair compressor
(See page AC–17).
OK
Author:
Date:
425
DI–191
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check compressor lock sensor.
1
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the compressor lock sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of the compressor lock sensor connector.
OK:
Resistance: 65 – 125 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
2
N15622
0.2 V/Div.
Reference: Inspection using oscilloscope
During cranking or idling, measure voltage between terminals
LOCK IN Signal Waveform
LOCK IN and E1 of the ECM.
HINT:
The correct waveform appears as shown in the illustration on
the left.
0V
NG
20 msec./Division (Idling)
Replace compressor lock sensor
(See page AC–40).
N02774
OK
3
Check harness and connector between A/C compressor lock sensor and ECM
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
426
DI–192
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
DI01O–04
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the temperature inside the cooling unit and sends the appropriate signals to the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
5V
1
L–W
II2
L–R
1
11
10
E8
E8
(*2)
(*1)
THR
A/C Evaporator
Temp. Sensor
2
9
3
BR
II2
BR
E8
E2
*1: w/o Immobiliser
*2: w/ Immobiliser
A03611
Author:
Date:
427
DI–193
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals THR and E2 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals THR and E1 of the ECM
connector at each temperature.
OK:
Voltage
at 0°C (32 F): 2.2 – 2.6 V
at 15°C (59°F): 1.4 – 1.8 V
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
ON
w/o Immobiliser
E1 (–)
THR (+)
w/ Immobiliser
OK
BE3840
I00180
A03031
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
THR (+)
E1 (–)
A03452
NG
2
Check A/C evaporator temp. sensor.
Thermometer
Ice
Ohmmeter
Thermistor
More than
10 cm (3.94 in.)
AC0175
PREPARATION:
Remove the A/C evaporator temp. sensor
(See page AC–30).
CHECK:
Check resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of the A/C evaporator temp. sensor connector at each temperature.
OK:
Resistance
at 0°C (32°F): 4.6 – 5.1 Ω
at 15°C (59°F): 2.1 – 2.6 Ω
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
NG
Replace A/C evaporator temp. sensor.
OK
Author:
Date:
428
DI–194
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (5S–FE)
Check harness and connector between A/C evaporator temp. sensor and ECM
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
429
DI–195
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI078–08
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following page.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Titles inside
are titles of pages in
this manual with the page number indicated
in the bottom portion. See the indicated
pages for detailed explanations.
1
Customer Problem Analysis P. DI–196
2
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 P. DI–197
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tool, inspect DLC3 P. DI–197
3
Check DTC and Freezed Frame Data (Precheck)
Record or Print DTC and Freezed Frame Data P. DI–197
4
Clear DTC and Freezed Frame Data P. DI–197
5
Visual Inspection
6
Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis P. DI–197
7
Problem Symptom Confirmation
If the engine does not start, perform steps 10 and 12 first
Malfunction
occurs.
9
10
DTC Check P. DI–197
Normal
Malfunction code.
11
Basic Inspection P. DI–197
12
14
8
Malfunction does not occur.
Symptom Simulation P. IN – 23
Problem Symptoms Table P. DI–221
Parts Inspection
15
DTC Chart P. DI–211
13
Circuit Inspection P. DI–222
Check for Intermittent Problems P. DI–197
Identification of Problem
16
Adjustment, Repair
17
Confirmation Test
End
Author:
Date:
430
DI–196
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI079–02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
Model and Model
Year
Driver’s Name
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
Engine Model
License No.
Odometer Reading
Problem Symptoms
Customer’s Name
Engine does
not Start
Engine does not crank
Difficult to
Start
Engine cranks slowly
Other
Poor Idling
Incorrect first idle
Idling rpm is abnormal
Rough idling
Other
Poor
Driveability
Hesitation
Knocking
Engine Stall
Soon after starting
After accelerator pedal depressed
After accelerator pedal released
During A/C operation
Shifting from N to D
Other
km
miles
No initial combustion
Back fire
Other
No complete combustion
High (
rpm)
Low (
Muffler explosion (after–fire)
rpm)
Surging
Others
Dates Problem
Occurred
Constant
Other
Condition When
Problem Occurs
Problem Frequency
Sometimes (
times per
day/month)
Weather
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
Outdoor
Temperature
Hot
Warm
Cool
Cold (approx.
Place
Highway
Rough road
Engine Temperature
Engine Operation
Cold
Suburbs
Other
Warming up
Inner city
After warming up
Starting
Just after starting (
Constant speed
Driving
A/C switch ON/OFF
Other
Condition of MIL
Normal Mode
(Precheck)
Once only
Various/Other
°F/
°C)
Uphill
Downhill
Any temperature
min.)
Idling
Acceleration
Other
Racing
Deceleration
Remains on
Sometimes light up
Does not light up
Normal
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freezed frame data (
)
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freezed frame data (
)
)
DTC Inspection
Check Mode
Normal
Author:
)
Date:
431
DI–197
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07A–06
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure
is that you connect to the vehicle the OBD II scan
tool complying with SAE J1978 or TOYOTA hand–
held tester, and read off various data output from
the vehicle’s ECM.
FI0534
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester
A06134
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s on–
board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the emission control
system/components or in the powertrain control
components which affect vehicle emissions, or a
malfunction in the computer. In addition to the MIL
lighting up when a malfunction is detected, the applicable Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the ECM
memory (See page DI–211).
If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3 consecutive trips, the
MIL goes off but the DTCs remain recorded in the ECM memory.
To check the DTC, connect the OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to Data Link Connector
3 (DLC3) on the vehicle. The OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester also enables you to
erase the DTC and check freezed frame data and
various forms of engine data (For operating instructions, see the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book.).
DTC include SAE controlled codes and manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled codes must
be set as prescribed by the SAE, while manufacturer controlled codes can be set freely by the
manufacturer within the prescribed limits (See DTC
chart on page DI–211).
Author:
Date:
432
DI–198
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode
during normal vehicle use. It also has a check mode
for technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms
and troubleshoot. Most DTC use 2 trip detection
logic* to prevent erroneous detection, and ensure
thorough malfunction detection. By switching the
ECM to check mode when troubleshooting, the
technician can cause the MIL to light up for a malfunction that is only detected once or momentarily
(TOYOTA hand–held tester only). (See page
DI–197)
*2 trip detection logic:
When a malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is temporarily stored in the ECM memory. (1st
trip)
If the same malfunction is detected again during the second
drive test, this second detection causes the MIL to light up. (2nd
trip) (However, the IG switch must be turned OFF between the
1st trip and the 2nd trip.).
Freeze frame data:
Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when a misfire (DTCs P0300 ∼ P0306) or fuel trim
malfunction (DTCs P0171, P0172) or other malfunction (first malfunction only), is detected.
Because freeze frame data records the engine
conditions (fuel system, calculated load, engine
coolant temperature, fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, etc.) when the malfunction is detected,
when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich,
etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Priorities for troubleshooting:
If troubleshooting priorities for multiple DTC are given in the applicable DTC chart, these should be followed.
If no instructions are given troubleshoot DTC according to the
following priorities.
(1) DTC other than fuel trim malfunction (DTCs P0171,
P0172), EGR (DTCs P0401, P0402) and misfire
(DTCs P0300 ∼ P0306).
(2) Fuel trim malfunction (DTCs P0171, P0172) and
EGR (DTCs P0401, P0402).
(3) Misfire (DTCs P0300 ∼ P0306).
Author:
Date:
433
DI–199
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check the DLC3.
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141–2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE
J1962 and matches the ISO 9141–2 format.
DLC3
N09214
Terminal No.
Connection / Voltage or Resistance
Condition
7
Bus Line / Pulse generation
During transmission
4
Chassis Ground ↔ Body Ground /1 Ω or less
Always
5
Signal Ground ↔ Body Ground /1 Ω or less
Always
16
Battery Positive ↔ Body Ground /9 ∼ 14 V
Always
HINT:
If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE”
when you have connected the cable of the OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch
ON and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle side or tool side.
If communication is normal when the tool is connected to
another vehicle, inspect DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in the
tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in the
tool’s instruction manual.
2.
(a)
S04159
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (Normal Mode)
Check the MIL.
(1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned
ON and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter
(See page BE–46).
(2) When the engine started, the MIL should go off. If
the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system has detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
(b) Check the DTC.
NOTICE:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only: When the diagnosis system is switched from normal mode to check mode, it erases
all DTC and freezed frame data recorded in normal mode.
So before switching modes, always check the DTC and
freezed frame data, and note them down.
(1) Prepare the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Author:
Date:
434
DI–200
DIAGNOSTICS
(2)
(3)
(4)
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester to DLC3 at the lower center of the instrument panel.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II
scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester switch ON.
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to check the DTC and freezed frame data and
note them down (For operating instructions, see the
OBD II scan tool’s instruction book.).
See page DI–197 to confirm the details of the DTC.
(5)
NOTICE:
When simulating symptoms with an OBD II scan tool
(excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) to check the
DTC, use normal mode. For code on the DTC chart
subject to ”2 trip detection logic”, performe the following either action.
Turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is
simulated the first time. Then repeat the simulation
process again. When the problem has been simulated
twice, the MIL lights up and the DTCs are recorded in
the ECM.
Check the 1st trip DTC using Mode 7 (Continuous Test
Results) for SAE J1979.
(c) Clear the DTC.
The DTCs and freezed frame data will be erased by either
action.
Operating the OBD II scan tool (complying
with SAE J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase the codes. (See the OBD II scan
tool’s instruction book for operating instructions.)
Disconnecting the battery terminals or EFI
fuse.
NOTICE:
If the TOYOTA hand–held tester switches the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice–versa, or if the ignition
switch is turned from ON to ACC or OFF during check
mode, the DTCs and freezed frame data will be erased.
3.
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (Check Mode)
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only:
Compared to the normal mode, the check mode has an increased sensitivity to detect malfunctions.
Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are detected in
the normal mode can also be detected in the check mode.
Author:
Date:
435
DI–201
DIAGNOSTICS
(a)
–
Check the DTC.
(1) Initial conditions.
Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
Throttle valve fully closed
Transmission in ”P” or ”N” position
Air conditioning switched OFF
(2) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(3) Prepare the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
(4) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC3 at the lower center of the instrument panel.
(5) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA
hand–held tester switch ON.
(6)
Flashing
ON
OFF
0.13 Seconds
FI3605
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester normal mode
to check mode (Check that the MIL flashes.).
NOTICE:
If the TOYOTA hand–held tester switches the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice–versa, or if the ignition switch is turned from ON to ACC or OFF during check
mode, the DTC and freezed frame data will be erased.
(7) Start the engine (The MIL goes out after the engine
start.).
(8) Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by the customer.
NOTICE:
Leave the ignition switch ON until you have checked the
DTC, etc.
(9) After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
TOYOTA hand–held tester diagnosis selector to
check the DTC and freezed frame data, etc.
HINT:
Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF. Turning the ignition
switch OFF switches the diagnosis system from check mode to
normal mode. So all DTC, etc. are erased.
(10) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
Author:
Date:
436
DI–202
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
4.
FAIL–SAFE CHART
If any of the following codes is recorded, the ECM enters fail–safe mode.
DTC No.
Fail–Safe Operation
Fail–Safe Deactivation Conditions
P0100
Ignition timing fixed at 10° BTDC
Returned to normal condition
P0110
Intake air temperature is fixed at 20°C (68°F)
Returned to normal condition
P0115
Engine coolant temperature is fixed at 80°C (176°F)
Returned to normal condition
P0120
VTA is fixed at 0°
The following condition must be repeated at least 2 times
consecutively
(a) Vehicle speed: 0km/h (0mph)
(b) VTA 0.1 V and 0.95 V
P0135
P0141
P0155
The heater circuit in which an abnormality is detected is
turned off
Ignition switch OFF
P0325
P0330
Max. timing retardation
Ignition switch OFF
P1300
Fuel cut
IGF signal is detected for 6 consecutive ignition
5.
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER only:
By putting the vehicle’s ECM in check mode, 1 trip detection logic is possible instead of 2 trip detection logic
and sensitivity to detect open circuits is increased. This makes it easier to detect intermittent problems.
(1) Clear the DTC (See page DI–197).
(2) Set the check mode (See page DI–197).
(3) Perform a simulation test (See page IN–21).
(4) Check the connector and terminal (See page IN–31).
(5) Handle the connector (See page IN–31).
6.
BASIC INSPECTION
When the malfunction code is not confirmed in the DTC check, troubleshooting should be performed in the
order for all possible circuits to be considered as the causes of the problems. In many cases, by carrying
out the basic engine check shown in the following flow chart, the location causing the problem can be found
quickly and efficiently. Therefore, use of this check is essential in engine troubleshooting.
1
Is battery positive voltage 11 V or more when engine is stopped ?
NO
Charge or replace battery.
YES
Author:
Date:
437
DI–203
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Is engine cranked?
NO
Proceed to page ST–18 and continue to troubleshoot.
NO
Go to step 7.
YES
3
Does engine start?
YES
4
Check air filter.
PREPARATION:
Remove the air filter.
CHECK:
Visually check that the air filter is not dirty or excessive oily.
HINT:
If necessary, clean the filter with compressed air. First blow from
inside thoroughly, then blow from outside of the filter.
Outside
Inside
P00495
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
438
DI–204
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check idle speed.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Switch off all accessories.
(c) Switch off air conditioning.
(d) Shift transmission into ”N” position.
(e) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 on the vehicle.
CHECK:
Use CURRENT DATA to check the idle speed.
OK:
Idle speed: 650 ∼ 750 rpm
NG
Proceed to problem symptoms table on
page DI–221.
OK
6
Check ignition timing.
DLC1
TE1
E1
SST
DLC1
P12915
P12952
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Switch off all accessories.
(c) Switch off air conditioning.
(d) Shift transmission into ”N” position.
(e) Keep the engine speed at idle.
(f)
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(g) Using a timing light, connect the tester to check wire.
CHECK:
Check ignition timing.
OK:
Ignition timing: 10° BTDC at idle
A00209
NG
Proceed to page IG–1 and continue to
troubleshoot.
OK
Proceed to problem symptoms table on page
DI–221.
Author:
Date:
439
DI–205
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check fuel pressure.
P20186
PREPARATION:
(a) Be sure that enough fuel is in the tank.
(b) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(d) Use ACTIVE TEST mode to operate the fuel pump.
(e) If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, connect the
positive (+) and negative (–) leads from the battery to the
fuel pump connector (See page SF–6).
CHECK:
Check that the pulsation damper screw rises up when the fuel
pump operates.
NG
Proceed to page SF–6 and continue to
troubleshoot.
OK
Author:
Date:
440
DI–206
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for spark.
P23917
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ignition coil or disconnect the high–tension
cord from the spark plug.
(b) Remove the spark plug.
(c) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil or high–tension
cord.
(d) Disconnect the injector connector.
(e) Hold the end about 12.5 mm (0.5 in.) from the ground.
CHECK:
Check if spark occurs while engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
To prevent excess fuel being injected from the injectors
during this test, don’t crank the engine for more than 5 ∼ 10
seconds at a time.
OK:
Spark jumps across electrode gap.
NG
Proceed to page IG–1 and continue to
troubleshoot.
OK
Proceed to problem symptoms table on page
DI–221.
Author:
Date:
441
DI–207
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
7.
ENGINE OPERATING CONDITION
NOTICE:
The values given below for ”Normal Condition” are representative values, so a vehicle may still be
normal even if its value varies from those listed here. So do not decide whether a part is faulty or
not solely according to the ”Normal Condition” here.
(a) CARB mandated signals.
TOYOTA hand–held tester display
Measurement Item
Normal Condition*
FUEL SYS #1
Fuel System Bank 1
OPEN: Air–fuel ratio feedback stopped
CLOSED: Air–fuel ratio feedback operating
Idling after warming up: CLOSED
FUEL SYS #2
Fuel System Bank 2
OPEN: Air–fuel ratio feedback stopped
CLOSED: Air–fuel ratio feedback operating
Idling after warming up: CLOSED
CALC LOAD
Calculator Load:
Current intake air volume as a proportion of max.
intake air volume
Idling: 13.1 ∼ 18.7%
Racing without load (2,500rpm): 11.7 ∼ 17.3%
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor Value
After warming up: 80 ∼ 95°C (176 ∼ 203°F)
COOLANT TEMP.
SHORT FT #1
Short–term Fuel Trim Bank 1
0 ± 20%
LONG FT #1
Long–term Fuel Trim Bank 1
0 ± 20%
SHORT FT #2
Short–term Fuel Trim Bank 2
0 ± 20%
0 ± 20%
LONG FT #2
Long–term Fuel Trim Bank 2
ENGINE SPD
Engine Speed
Idling: 650 ∼ 750 rpm
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle Speed
Vehicle stopped: 0 km/h (0 mph)
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition Advance:
Ignition Timing of Cylinder No. 1
Idling: BTDC 10 ∼ 25.0°
Intake Air Temp. Sensor Value
Equivalent to Ambient Temp.
Air Flow Rate Through Mass Air Flow Meter
Idling: 3.3 ∼ 4.7 gm/sec.
Racing without load (2,500 rpm):
10.4 ∼ 15.4 gm/sec.
Voltage Output of Throttle Position Sensor
Calculated as a percentage:
0 V → 0%, 5 V → 100%
Throttle valve fully closed: 7 ∼ 11%
Throttle valve fully open: 65 ∼ 75%
INTAKE AIR
MAF
THROTTLE POS
*:
If no conditions are specifically stated for ”ldling”, it means the shift lever is at N or P position, the A/C switch
is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
Author:
Date:
442
DI–208
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA hand–held tester display
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Measurement Item
Normal Condition*1
O2S B1, S1
Voltage Output of Oxygen Sensor
Bank 1 Sensor 1
O2FT B1, S1
Oxygen Sensor Fuel Trim Bank 1 Sensor 1
(Same as SHORT FT #1)
O2S B1, S2
Voltage Output of Oxygen Sensor
Bank 1 Sensor 2
Driving 50 km/h (31 mph): 0.1 ∼ 0.9 V
O2S B2, S1
Voltage Output of Oxygen Sensor
Bank 2 Sensor 1
Idling: 0.1 ∼ 0.9 V (0.56 ∼ 0.76 V*2)
O2FT B2, S1
Oxygen Sensor Fuel Trim Bank 2 Sensor 1
(Same as SHORT FT #2)
A/FS B1, S1 *3
A/FS B2, S1 *3
Idling: 0.1 ∼ 0.9 V (0.56 ∼ 0.76 V*2)
Voltage Output of A/F Sensor Bank 1 Sensor 1
Voltage Output of A/F Sensor Bank 2 Sensor 1
0 ± 20%
0 ± 20%
Idling: 2.8 ∼ 3.8 V
Idling: 2.8 ∼ 3.8 V
A/FFT B1, S1 *3
A/F Sensor Fuel Trim Bank 1 Sensor 1
(Same as SHORT FT #1)
O ± 20%
A/FFT B2, S1 *3
A/F Sensor Fuel Trim Bank 2 Sensor 1
(Same as SHORT FT #1)
O ± 20%
*1: If no conditions are specifically stated for ”Idling”, it means the shift lever is shift lever is at N or P position,
the A/C switch is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
*2: Only for California Specification vehicles, when you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–
held tester).
*3: Only for California Specification vehicles, when you use the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Author:
Date:
443
DI–209
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
TOYOTA Enhanced Signals.
TOYOTA hand–held tester display
Measurement Item
Normal Condition*
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire range
Misfire 0: 0 rpm
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range
Misfire 0: 0 g/r
Fuel injection time for cylinder No.1
Idling: 1.6 ∼ 2.9 ms
Intake Air Control Valve Duty Ratio
Opening ratio rotary solenoid type IAC valve
Idling: 27 ∼ 47 %
Starter Signal
Cranking: ON
CTP SIG
Closed Throttle Position Signal
Throttle Fully Closed: ON
A/C SIG
A/C Switch Signal
A/C ON: ON
PNP SW
Park/Neutral Position Switch Signal
P or N position: ON
Electrical Load Signal
Defogger switch ON: ON
Stop Light Switch Signal
Stop light switch ON: ON
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Signal
Turn steering wheel: ON
FC IDL
Fuel Cut Idle: Fuel cut when throttle valve fully
closed, during deceleration
Fuel cut operating: ON
FC TAU
Fuel Cut TAU: Fuel cut during very light load
Fuel cut operating: ON
INJECTOR
IAC DUTY RATIO
STARTER SIG
ELCTRCL LOAD SIG
STOP LIGHT SW
PS OIL PRESS SW
CYL#1 ∼ CYL#6
Abnormal revolution variation for each cylinder
0%
IGNITION
Total number of ignition for every 1,000 revolutions
0 ∼ 3,000
EGR Gas Temperature Sensor Value
EGR not operating:
Temperature between intake air temp. and
engine coolant temp.
Intake Air Control Valve VSV Signal
VSV operating: ON
EGR SYSTEM
EGR system operating condition
Idling: OFF
A/C CUT SIG
A/C Cut Signal
A/C S/W OFF: ON
FUEL PUMP
Fuel Pump Signal
Idling: ON
EVAP (PURGE) VSV
EVAP VSV Signal
VSV operating: Above 30%
VAPOR PRESS VSV
Vapor Pressure VSV Signal
VSV operating: ON (TANK)
EGRT GAS
INTAKE CTRL VSV
*:
If no conditions are specifically stated for ”ldling”, it means the shift lever is at N or P position, the A/C switch
is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
Author:
Date:
444
DI–210
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA hand–held tester display
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Measurement Item
Normal Condition*1
Total Fuel Trim Bank 1: Average value for fuel
trim system of bank 1
Idling: 0.8 ∼ 1.2
Total Fuel Trim Bank 1: Average value for fuel
trim system of bank 2
Idling: 0.8 ∼ 1.2
O2 LR B1, S1 *2
Oxygen Sensor Lean Rich Bank 2 Sensor 1 Response time for oxygen sensor output to switch
from lean to rich
Idling after warmed up: 0 ∼ 1,000 msec.
O2 LR B2, S1 *2
Oxygen Sensor Lean Rich Bank 2 Sensor 1 Response time for oxygen sensor output to switch
from lean to rich
Idling after warmed up: 0 ∼ 1,000 msec.
O2 RL B1, S1 *2
Oxygen Sensor Rich Lean Bank 1 Sensor 1 Response time for oxygen sensor output to switch
from rich to lean
Idling after warmed up: 0 ∼ 1,000 msec.
O2 RL B2, S1 *2
Oxygen Sensor Rich Lean Bank 2 Sensor 1 Response time for oxygen sensor output to switch
from rich to lean
Idling after warmed up: 0 ∼ 1,000 msec.
TOTAL FT B1
TOTAL FT B2
*1: If no conditions are specifically stated for ”Idling”, it means the shift lever is at N or P position, the A/C
switch is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
*2: Except California Specification vehicles.
Author:
Date:
445
DI–211
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07B–07
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
SAE CONTROLLED
HINT:
Parameters listed in the chart may not be exactly the same as your reading due to the type of instrument
or other factors.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check in check mode, check the circuit for that code listed
in the table below. For details of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ’’See page ’’ for the respective ’’DTC No.’’ in the DTC chart.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
P0100
(DI–222)
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
P0101
(DI–227)
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Range/Performance
Problem
Mass air flow meter
P0110
(DI–228)
Intake Air Temp. Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Intake air temp. sensor (built into mass air flow meter)
ECM
P0115
(DI–233)
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
P0116
(DI–237)
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Cooling system
P0120
(DI–239)
Throttle/Pedal Position
Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0121
(DI–243)
Throttle/Pedal Position
Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
Throttle position sensor
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for
Closed Loop Fuel Control
(Except California Spec.)
Fuel system
Injector
Ignition system
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
(bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
ECM
*3
P0125
(DI–249)
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for
Closed Loop Fuel Control
(Only for California Spec.)
Fuel system
Injector
Ignition system
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
ECM
*2
P0130
(DI–255)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
*2
P0125
(DI–244)
*1: MIL lights up
*2: Except California specification vehicles
*3: Only for California specification vehicle
Author:
Date:
446
DI–212
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
*2
P0133
(DI–259)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Slow Response
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
*2
P0135
(DI–263)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
ECM
P0136
(DI–265)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor
P0141
(DI–263)
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Same as DTC No. P0135
*1
*3
P0150
(DI–255)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P0130
*1
*3
P0153
(DI–259)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Slow Response
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P0133
Fuel trim malfunction
*1
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P0135
*1
System too Lean
(Fuel Trim)
(Except California Spec.)
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Gas leakage on exhaust system
*1
System too Rich
(Fuel Trim)
(Except California Spec.)
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Gas leakage on exhaust system
*1
System too Lean
(Fuel Trim)
(Only for California Spec.)
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
*1
System too rich
(Fuel Trim)
(Only for California Spec.)
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Heated oxygen sensor malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
*1
*3
P0155
(DI–263)
*3
P0171
(DI–272)
*3
P0172
(DI–272)
*4
P0171
(DI–267)
*4
P0172
(DI–267)
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
–
MIL lights up
MIL light up or blinking
Except California specification vehicles
Only for California specification vehicle
Author:
Date:
447
DI–213
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel line pressure
EGR
Compression pressure
Valve clearance not to specification
Valve timing
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Open or short engine wire
Connector connection
ECM
*2
P0300
(DI–276)
Random/Multiple Cylinder
Misfire Detected
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
P0305
P0306
(DI–276)
Misfire Detected
– Cylinder 1
– Cylinder 2
– Cylinder 3
– Cylinder 4
– Cylinder 5
– Cylinder 6
P0325
(DI–283)
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in knock sensor 1 circuit
Knock sensor 1 (looseness)
ECM
*1
P0330
(DI–283)
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in knock sensor 2 circuit
Knock sensor 2 (looseness)
ECM
*1
P0335
(DI–287)
Crankshaft Position Sensor
”A” Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Starter
ECM
*1
P0340
(DI–290)
Camshaft Position Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Starter
ECM
*1
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Flow Insufficient Detected
EGR valve (stuck closed)
Open or short in EGR gas temp. sensor circuit
EGR gas temp. sensor
Open in VSV circuit for EGR
VSV for EGR
Vacuum control valve
Vacuum hose disconnected or blocked
ECM
*1
P0402
(DI–302)
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Flow Excessive Detected
EGR valve stuck open
VSV for EGR open malfunction
Short in VSV circuit for EGR
Open or short in EGR valve position sensor circuit
EGR valve position sensor
ECM
*1
*3
P0420
(DI–305)
Catalyst System Efficiency
Below Threshold
(Except California Spec.)
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
Heated oxygen sensor
*2
Catalyst System Efficiency
Below Threshold
(Only for California Spec.)
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, sensor 2)
circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, sensor 2)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
*2
P0401
(DI–292)
*4
P0420
(DI–308)
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
Detection Item
–
MIL lights up
MIL lights up on U.S.A and Canadian specification vehicles
Except California specification vehicles
Only for California specification vehicle
Author:
Date:
448
DI–214
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*
Memory
*1
Evaporative Emission Control
System Malfunction
Vapor pressure sensor
Fuel tank cap incorrectly installed
Fuel tank cap cracked or damaged
Vacuum hose cracked, holed, blocked, damaged or
disconnected ((1) or (2) in fig. 1)
Hose or tube cracked, holed, damaged or loose seal
((3) in fig. 1)
Fuel tank cracked, holed or damaged
Charcoal canister cracked, holed or damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracked or damaged
Evaporative Emission Control
System Incorrect Purge Flow
Open or short in VSV circuit for EVAP
Open or short in VSV circuit for vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
VSV for EVAP
VSV for vapor pressure sensor
Vapor pressure sensor
Vacuum hose cracks, holed blocked, damaged or
disconnected ((1), (4), (5), (6) and (7) in fig.1)
Charcoal canister cracks, holed or damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracked or damaged
P0446
(DI–318)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Vent Control
Malfunction
Open or short in VSV circuit for EVAP
Open or short in VSV circuit for vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
VSV for EVAP
VSV for vapor pressure sensor
Vapor pressure sensor
Vacuum hose cracks, holed blocked, damaged or
disconnected ((1), (4), (5), (6) and (7) in fig.1)
Charcoal canister cracks, holed or damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracked or damaged
P0450
(DI–331)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor
Malfunction
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
P0451
(DI–331)
Evaporative Emission Control
System Pressure Sensor
Range/Performance
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor pressure sensor
ECM
P0500
(DI–333)
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Malfunction
Open or short in speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
P0505
(DI–336)
Idle Control System
Malfunction
IAC valve is stuck or closed
Open or short in IAC valve circuit
Open or short in A/C signal circuit
Air intake (hose loose)
P0440
(DI–311)
P0441
(DI–318)
*:
MIL lights up
Author:
Date:
449
DI–215
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
MANUFACTURER CONTROLLED
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
*2
P1130
(DI–340)
A/F Sensor Circuit
Range/Performance Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
*2
P1133
(DI–345)
Trouble Area
MIL*1
Memory
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
ECM
A/F Sensor Circuit Response
Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
*2
P1135
(DI–349)
A/F Sensor Heater Circuit
Malfunction
(Bank1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) heater
ECM
*2
P1150
(DI–340)
A/F Sensor Circuit
Range/Performance Malfunction
(Bank2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P1130
*2
P1153
(DI–345)
A/F Sensor Circuit Response
Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P1133
*2
P1155
(DI–349)
A/F Sensor Heater Circuit
Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Same as DTC No. P1135
P1300
(DI–351)
Igniter Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter to ECM
Igniter
ECM
P1335
(DI–357)
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(during engine running)
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Starter
ECM
–
P1410
(DI–358)
EGR Valve Position Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in EGR valve position sensor circuit
EGR valve position sensor
ECM
P1411
(DI–362)
EGR Valve Position Sensor
Circuit Range/Performance
Problem
EGR valve position sensor
P1520
(DI–363)
Stop Light Switch Signal
Malfunction
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
P1600
(DI–366)
ECM BATT Malfunction
Open in back up power source circuit
ECM
P1780
(DI–368)
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Malfunction
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
*1: MIL lights up, – MIL does not light up
*2: Only for California specification vehicles
Author:
Date:
450
DI–216
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
–
Detection Item
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Trouble Area
MIL*
Memory
B2795
(DI–928)
Unmatched key Code
Immobiliser system
–
B2796
(DI–929)
No Communication in
Immobiliser System
Immobiliser system
–
B2797
(DI–932)
Communication Malfunction No.1
Immobiliser system
–
B2798
(DI–935)
Communication Malfunction No.2
Immobiliser system
–
*:– MIL does not light up
Author:
Date:
451
DI–217
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07C–06
PARTS LOCATION
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
ECM
VSV for ACIS
Injector
VSV for EGR
EGR Valve
Position Sensor
VSV for EVAP
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DLC1
Knock Sensor 2
Crankshaft Position
Sensor
DLC3
Igniter
Mass Air Flow Meter
Camshaft Position
Sensor
IAC Valve
Heated Oxygen Sensor *1
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Park/Neutral Position Switch
A/F Sensor*2
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Heated Oxygen Sensor *1
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
A/F Sensor*2
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
Knock Sensor 1
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
Canister
*1 : Except California Specification vehicles
*2 : Only for California Specification vehicles
A07469
Author:
Date:
452
DI–218
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI4DP–01
TERMINALS OF ECM
ECM Terminals
E11
E10
E9
E8
E7
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
21201918171615141312 1110
313029 28 27 2625242322
76 5 4 3 2 1
1615141312 1110 9 8
242322 2120191817
6 5 4 3 2 1
121110 9 8 7
1716 151413
9 8 7
6 5 4 3 21
191817161514131211 10
282726252423 222120
7 6
5 4 3 2 1
151413121110 9 8
2221201918 1716
A02508
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
BATT (E7 – 1) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B–Y ↔ BR
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
Always
9 ∼ 14
+B (E7 – 16) – E1 (E10 – 17)
R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
VC (E10 – 2) – E2 (E10 – 18)
Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON
4.5 ∼ 5.5
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully closed
0.3 ∼ 1.0
IG switch ON
Throttle valve fully open
3.2 ∼ 4.9
P ↔ R–B
Idling , A/C switch OFF
1.1 ∼ 1.5
THA (E10 – 22) – E2 (E10 – 18)
L–Y ↔ BR
Idling, Intake air temp. 20°C (68°F)
0.5 ∼ 3.4
THW (E10 –14) – E2 (E10 – 18)
G–B ↔ BR
Idling, Engine coolant temp. 80°C (176°F)
0.2 ∼ 1.0
STA (E7 – 7) – E1 (E10 – 17)
GR ↔ BR
Cranking
VTA1 (E10 – 23)
– E2 (E10 – 18)
VG (E10 – 10)
– E2G (E10 – 19)
L ↔ BR
6.0 or more
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#10 (E10 – 5)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
L ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–276)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#20 (E10 – 6)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
R ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–276)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#30 (E11 – 1)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
Y ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–276)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#40 (E11 – 2)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
W ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–276)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#50 (E11 – 3)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
R–L ↔ BR
Pulse generation
(See page DI–276)
Idling
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
#60 (E11 – 4)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
IGT1 (E11 – 11)
– E1 (E10– 17)
IGT2 (E11 – 12)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
IGT3 (E11 – 13)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
G ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–276)
GR ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–351)
BR–Y ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–351)
LG–B ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–351)
Author:
Date:
453
DI–219
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
IGF (E11 – 25) – E1 (E10 – 17)
W–R ↔ BR
THG (E10 – 13)
G–Y ↔ BR
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
4.5 ∼ 5.5
IG switch ON
– E2 (E10 – 18)
Pulse generation
(See page DI–351)
Idling
4.5 ∼ 5.5
IG switch ON
G22+ (E11 – 10)
– NE– (E10 – 24)
B–W ↔ L
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–287)
NE+ (E10 – 16)
– NE– (E10 – 24)
B–R ↔ L
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–287)
Taillight switch ON
7.5 ∼ 14
Taillight switch OFF
0 ∼ 1.5
Defogger switch ON
7.5 ∼ 14
Defogger switch OFF
0 ∼ 1.5
Y–G ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
ACIS (E11 – 17)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
R–Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
G R ↔ BR
G–R
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
FC (E7 – 3) – E01 (E11 – 21)
Idling
0 ∼ 3.0
ELS (E7 – 19) – E1 (E10 – 17)
G O ↔ BR
G–O
ELS2 (E7 – 18) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B Y ↔ BR
B–Y
EGR (E11 – 18)
– E01 (E11 –21)
EVP1 (E10 – 7)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
LG ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
RSC (E11 – 15)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
Y–B ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Disconnect E11 of ECM connector
9 ∼ 14
RSO (E11 – 16)
– E01 (E11 – 21)
R–W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Disconnect E11 of ECM connector
9 ∼ 14
*OXR1 (E10 – 11)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
W ↔ BR
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for 2 min. after
warming up
Pulse generation
(See page DI–305)
*OXL1 (E10 – 12)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
B ↔ BR
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for 2 min. after
warming up
Pulse generation
(See page DI–305)
OXS (E8 – 8) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B ↔ BR
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for 2 min. after
warming up
Pulse generation
(See page DI–305)
*HTL (E10–
(E10 4) – E03 (E11 – 30)
Y R ↔ BR
Y–R
*HTR
HTR (E10 – 3)
– E03 (E11 – 30)
L B ↔ BR
L–B
HTS (E8 – 9) – E03 (E11 –30)
30)
P G ↔ BR
P–G
9 ∼ 14
Idling
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
9 ∼ 14
Idling
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
9 ∼ 14
Idling
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
KNKR (E11 – 27)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
W ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–283)
KNKL (E11 – 28)–
E1 (E10 – 17)
W ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–283)
NSW (E7 – 20)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
SPD (E8 – 22) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B W ↔ BR
B–W
V–W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Other shift position in ”P” ,”N” position
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Shift position in ”P” ,”N” position
0 ∼ 3.0
IG switch ON
Rotate driving wheel slowly
Pulse generation
*: Only for except California specification vehicles
Author:
Date:
454
DI–220
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
TC (E11 – 6) – E1 (E10 – 17)
L–W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
W (E7 – 6) – E01 (E11 – 21)
G–R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
PS (E10 – 9) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B–L ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
A/C switch OFF
Below 2.0
ACT (E8 – 13) – E1 (E10 – 17)
LG B ↔ BR
LG–B
A/C (E8 – 25) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B Y ↔ BR
B–Y
CF (E11 – 29) – E1 (E10 – 17)
G W ↔ BR
G–W
TACH (E8– 27) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B–O ↔ BR
Idling
W–R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor
TPC (E7 – 9) – E01 (E11 – 21)
PTNK (E7 – 17)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
SIL (E7 – 11) – E1 (E10 – 17)
STP (E7 – 15) – E1 (E10 – 17)
L–R ↔ BR
W ↔ BR
G W ↔ BR
G–W
A/C switch ON at idling
9 ∼ 14
A/C switch ON at idling
Below 2.0
A/C switch OFF
9 ∼ 14
Electric cooling fan is operating on high speed
9 ∼ 14
Electric cooling fan is operating on low speed or OFF
0∼2
Pulse generation
9 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
3.0 ∼ 3.6
IG switch ON
Apply vacuum 2.0 kPa (15 mmHg, 0.6 in.Hg)
1.3 ∼ 2.1
During transmission
Pulse generation
IG switch ON
Brake pedal depressed
7.5 ∼ 14
IG switch ON
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5
IG switch ON
Apply vacuum (0 kPa, 0 mmHg, 0 in.Hg) to EGR valve
0.4 ∼ 1.6
IG switch ON
Apply vacuum (17.3 kPa, 130 mmHg, 5.12 in.Hg) to EGR valve
3.2 ∼ 5.1
EGLS (E11 – 22)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
W G ↔ BR
W–G
*1 AFR+ (E10 – 11
– E1 (E10 – 17)
BR ↔ BR
IG switch ON
3.3*
*1 AFR– (E10 – 20)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
B–R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
3.0*
*1 AFL+ (E10 – 12)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
B–W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
3.3*
*1 AFL– (E10 – 21)
– E1 (E10 – 17)
L ↔ BR
IG switch ON
3.0*
*1 HAFR (E10 – 3)
– E04 (E10 – 1)
B R ↔ BR
B–R
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
*1 HAFL (E10 – 4)
– E05 (E10 – 8)
B W ↔ BR
B–W
KSW (E8 – 11) – E1 (E10 – 17)
L B ↔ BR
L–B
RXCK (E9 – 5) – E1 (E10 – 17)
R–L ↔ BR
At time of inserting the key
Pulse generation
CODE (E9 – 4) – E1 (E10 – 17)
G–W ↔ BR
At time of inserting the key
Pulse generation
IGSW (E7 – 2) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B–R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
TXCT (E9– 10) – E1 (E10 – 17)
L–Y ↔ BR
At time of inserting the key
Pulse
IMLD (E9 – 16) – E1 (E10 – 17)
R–Y ↔ BR
In condition without the key inserted
Pulse
MREL (E7 – 8) – E1 (E10 – 17)
B–R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
Idling (warm up the engine)
Pulse generation
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
Idling (warm up the engine)
Pulse generation
At time of inserting the key
Below 1.5
4∼ 5
In condition without the key inserted
*: The ECM terminal voltage is fixed regardless of the output voltage from the sensor.
*1: Only for California specification vehicles
Author:
Date:
455
DI–221
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07E–06
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Engine does not crank (Does not start)
1. Starter
2. Starter relay
ST–18
ST–20
No initial combustion (Does not start)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Engine control module (ECM)
DI–369
DI–374
IN–31
No complete combustion (Does not start)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–374
Engine cranks normally (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Compression
DI–384
DI–374
EM–3
Cold engine (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–384
DI–374
Hot engine (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–384
DI–374
High engine idle speed (Poor idling)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor Circuit)
2. ECM power source circuit
AC–88
DI–369
Low engine idle speed (Poor idling)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor Circuit)
2. Fuel pump control circuit
AC–88
DI–374
Rough idling (Poor idling)
1. Compression
2. Fuel pump control circuit
EM–3
DI–374
Hunting (Poor idling)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–369
DI–374
Hesitation/Poor acceleration (Poor driveability)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
2. A/T faulty
DI–374
DI–453
Surging (Poor driveability)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–374
Soon after starting (Engine stall)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–374
During A/C operation (Engine stall)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor Circuit)
2. Engine control module (ECM)
AC–88
IN–31
Unable to refuel/Difficult to refuel
1. ORVR system
EC–6
Author:
Date:
456
DI–222
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07F–06
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
P0100
Mass Air Flow Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a platinum hot wire,
thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow meter works on the principle
that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the housing detect any changes in the
intake air temperature.
The hot wire is maintained at the set temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This
current flow is then measured as the output voltage of the mass air flow meter.
The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power
transistor controlled so that the potential of A and B remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
B+
Thermistor
Power Transistor
Platinum Hot wire
A
B
Output
Voltage
Platinum Hot
Wire
FI6929
S05741
A00435
DTC No.
P0100
Thermistor
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit with more than 3
sec. engine speed 4,000 rpm or less
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
If the ECM detects DTC 0100 it operates the fail–safe function, keeping the ignition timing and injection volume constant and making it possible to drive the vehicle.
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0100, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the mass
air flow ratio from ”CURRENT DATA”.
Mass Air Flow Value (gm/sec.)
0.0
271.0 or more
Malfunction
Mass air flow meter power source circuit open
VG circuit open or short
E2G circuit open
Author:
Date:
457
DI–223
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room J/B
1
F9
Fusible
Link
Block
EFI 5
3
2
1
2
2J
7
2K
R
B–W
F4
Battery
B–Y
W–B
B–G
1
FL
MAIN
ECM
9 II3
EFI Relay
B–Y
1
2A
5
2C
B
Junction
Connector
B
B
B–Y
J28
J27
A
Junction
Connector
A
J36
A J20
Junction
A Connector
4
10
VG
E10
5
19
E2G
R–B
E10
3
P
J35
B+
Mass Air
Flow Meter
EB
B–W
E2
8 MREL
E7
A06156
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
458
DI–224
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of mass
air flow rate.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
(c) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Read mass air flow rate on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
RESULT:
Mass air flow rate (gm/sec.)
2
Type II
0.0
271.0 or more
Type I
Go to step 2.
Type II
Go to step 5.
Check voltage of mass air flow meter power source.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 4 of mass air flow meter connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
BE6653
S05337
Type I
4 (+)
A00436
NG
Check for open in harness and connector
between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and
mass air flow meter (See page IN–31).
OK
Author:
Date:
459
DI–225
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminal VG of ECM connector and body ground.
VG (+)
A02017
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal VG of the ECM connector
and body ground while engine is idling.
OK:
Voltage:
1.1 ∼ 1.5 V (P or N position and A/C switch OFF)
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
4
Check for open and short in harness and connector between mass air flow meter
and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace mass air flow meter.
Author:
Date:
460
DI–226
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check continuity between terminal E2G of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal E2G of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
Continuity (1 Ω or less)
E2G
A02018
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
6
Check for open in harness and connector between mass air flow meter and ECM
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace mass air flow meter.
Author:
Date:
461
DI–227
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07G–06
DTC
P0101
Mass Air Flow Circuit Range/Performance
Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0100 (Mass Air Flow Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–222.
DTC No.
P0101
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue 10 sec. or more with
engine speed NE < 900:
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Throttle valve fully closed
(b) Mass air flow meter output 2.2 V
(c) THW 70°C
Mass air flow meter
Conditions (a) and (b) continue 10 sec. or more with engine
speed 1,500 rpm or more:
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) VTA 0.63 V
(b) Mass air flow meter output 1.06 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0100 (Mass Air Flow Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–222.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0101) being output?
NO
Replace mass air flow meter.
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
Author:
Date:
462
DI–228
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07H–07
DTC
P0110
Intake Air Temp. Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The intake air temp. sensor is built into the air flow meter and senses the intake air temperature.
A thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value according to the intake air temperature.
The lower the intake air temperature, the greater the thermistor resistance value, and the higher the intake
air temperature, the lower the thermistor resistance value (See Fig. 1).
The intake air temperature sensor is connected to the ECM. The 5 V power source voltage in the ECM is
applied to the intake air temperature sensor from the terminal THA via resistor R.
That is, the resistor R and the intake air temperature sensor are connected in series. When the resistance
value of the intake air temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in the intake air temperature,
the potential at terminal THA also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases the fuel injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine operation.
If the ECM detects the DTC P0110, it operates the fail–safe function in which the intake air temperature is
assumed to be 20°C (68°F).
(fig. 1)
30
20
10
Resistance kΩ
5
Acceptable
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
– 20
(– 4)
0
32
20
68
40
104
60
140
80
176
100
212
Temp. °C (F°)
Intake air temp.
°C (°F)
Resistance
(kΩ)
Voltage
(V)
–20 (–4)
16.0
4.3
0 (32)
5.9
3.4
20 (68)
2.5
2.4
40 (104)
1.1
1.4
60 (140)
0.6
0.9
80 (176)
0.3
0.5
100 (212)
0.1
0.2
FI4741
DTC No.
P0110
DTC Detecting Condition
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Trouble Area
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Intake air temp. sensor (built into mass air flow meter)
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0110, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the intake
air temp. from ”CURRENT DATA”.
Temp. Displayed
Malfunction
–40°C ( –40°F )
Open circuit
140°C ( 284°F ) or more
Short circuit
Author:
Date:
463
DI–229
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Intake Air Temp. Sensor
(Inside the Mass Air Flow Meter)
5V
1
L–Y
2
BR
22
E10
R
THA
18
E10
E2
E1
FI6448
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0110 (Intake Air Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0120 (Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction) and P1410 (EGR Valve
Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction) are output simultaneously, E2 (Sensor Ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
464
DI–230
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of
intake air temp.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
CHECK:
Read temp. value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Same as actual intake air temp.
HINT:
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates –40°C (−40°F).
If there is short circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
NG
–40°C (–40°F) ... Go to step 2.
140°C (284°F) or more ... Go to step 4.
OK
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
2
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Intake Air
Temp. Sensor
1
E10
18
E10
2
5V
22
THA
E2
A00210
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
(b) Connect sensor wire harness terminals together.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temp. value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temp. value: 140°C (284°F) or more
OK
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace mass air flow meter.
NG
Author:
Date:
465
DI–231
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Intake Air Temp. Sensor
22
E10
18
E10
THA
5V
THA
E2
E2
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Connect between terminals THA and E2 of ECM connector.
HINT:
Mass air flow meter connector is disconnected.
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector (See page IN–31).
CHECK:
Read temp. value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temp. value: 140°C (284°F) or more
A02019
OK
Open in harness between terminal E2 or THA,
repair or replace harness.
NG
Confirm good connection at ECM.
If OK, check and replace ECM.
4
Check for short in harness and ECM.
ON
ECM
Intake Air
Temp. Sensor
5V
22
E10
18
THA
E10
E2
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temp. value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temp. value: –40°C (–40°F)
A00212
OK
Replace mass air flow meter.
NG
Author:
Date:
466
DI–232
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for short in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Intake Air Temp. Sensor
5V
THA
E2
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Disconnect the E10 connector of ECM.
HINT:
Mass air flow meter connector is disconnected.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temp. value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temp. value: – 40°C (– 40°F)
OK
E10
Repair or replace harness or connector.
A02043
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
467
DI–233
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07I–06
DTC
P0115
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temp. sensor changes the resistance value according to the engine
coolant temp.
The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction shown on page DI–228.
If the ECM detects the DTC P0115, it operates fail–safe function in which the engine coolant temperature
is assumed to be 80°C (176°F).
DTC No.
P0115
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0115, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the engine
coolant temp. from CURRENT DATA.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
–40°C (–40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
5V
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
2
G–B
1
BR
14
E10
18
E10
THW
E2
E1
FI6448
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0110 (Intake Air Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0120 (Throttle/Pedal/Position Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction) and P1410 (EGR Valve
Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction) are output simultaneously, E2 (Sensor Ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
468
DI–234
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of engine
coolant temperature.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Same as actual engine coolant temperature.
HINT:
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates –40°C (–40°F).
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
NG
–40°C (–40°F) ... Go to step 2.
140°C (284°F) or more ... Go to step 4.
OK
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
2
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
2
E10
18
E10
1
5V
14
THW
E2
A00214
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the engine coolant temp. sensor connector.
(b) Connect the sensor wire harness terminals together.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temp. value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
OK
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
NG
Author:
Date:
469
DI–235
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
14
2
E10
18
E10
5V
THW
E2
1
THW
E2
A02020
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Connect between terminals THW and E2 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
Engine coolant temp. sensor connector is disconnected. Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector (See page IN–31).
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature. value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
OK
Open in harness between terminal E2 or THW,
repair or replace harness.
NG
Confirm good connection at ECM.
If OK, check and replace ECM.
4
Check for short in harness and ECM.
ON
ECM
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
5V
14
E10
18
E10
THW
E2
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the engine coolant temp. sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: –40°C (–40°F)
A00216
OK
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
NG
Author:
Date:
470
DI–236
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for short in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
5V
THW
E2
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Disconnect the E10 connector of the ECM.
HINT:
Engine coolant temp. sensor connector is disconnected.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: –40°C (–40°F)
OK
E10
Repair or replace harness or connector.
A02043
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
471
DI–237
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07J–06
DTC
P0116
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Range/
Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–233.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
If THW –7°C (19.4°F), 20 min. or more after starting
engine, engine coolant temp. sensor value is 20°C (68°F) or
less
(2 trip detection logic)
If THW –7°C (19.4°F) and 10°C (50°F), 5 min. or more
after starting engine,
engine coolant temp. sensor value is 20°C (68°F) or less
(2 trip detection logic)
P0116
If THW 10°C (50 °F), 2 min. or more after starting engine,
engine coolant temp. sensor value is 30°C (86°F)
(2 trip detection logic)
Engine coolant temp.
temp sensor
Cooling system
When THW 35°C (95°F) or more and less than 60°C
(140°F), THA – 6.7°C (19.9°F) or more, when starting
engine , condition (a) and (b) continues:
(a) Vehicle speed is changing (Not stable)
(b) When starting engine, THW< 3°C (37.4°F)
(2 trip detection logic)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0115 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction) and P0116 (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit
Range/Performance) are output simultaneously, engine coolant temp. sensor circuit may be open.
Perform troubleshooting of DTC P0115 first.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0116) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
472
DI–238
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check thermostat (See page CO–9).
NG
Replace thermostat.
OK
Replace engine coolant temp. sensor.
Author:
Date:
473
DI–239
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07K–06
DTC
P0120
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A”
Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and
detects the throttle valve opening angle. When the throttle valve
is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA
of the ECM increases in proportion to the opening angle of the
throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ∼ 5.2 V when the
throttle valve is fully opened. the ECM judges the vehicle driving
conditions from these signals input from terminals VTA and
uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air–fuel ratio
correction, power increase correction and fuel–cut control etc.
ECM
Throttle Position
Sensor
VC
VTA1
E2
P24296
DTC No.
P0120
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
Condition (a) or (b) continues:
(a) VTA 0.1 V
(b) VTA 4.9 V
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0120, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the throttle
valve opening percentage and closed throttle position switch condition.
Throttle valve opening position
expressed as percentage
Trouble Area
Throttle valve fully closed
Throttle valve fully open
0%
0%
VC line open
VTA line open or short
Approx. 100 %
Approx. 100 %
E2 line open
WIRING DIAGRAM
Throttle Position Sensor
ECM
1
Y
2
E10 VC
3
L
23
VTA1
E10
2
BR
18
E2
E10
5V
S05019
Author:
Date:
474
DI–240
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0110(Intake Air temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0115(Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction), P0120(Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction) and P1410 are output simultaneously, E2 (Sensor Ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read throttle valve
opening percentage.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the throttle valve opening percentage.
OK:
FI7052
OK
Throttle valve
Throttle valve opening position
expressed as percentage
Fully open
Approx. 75 %
Fully closed
Approx. 10 %
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
NG
Author:
Date:
475
DI–241
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminal 1 of wire harness side connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of wire harness side connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
ON
1 (+)
BE6653
S05338
A00437
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
3
Check throttle position sensor.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals 1, 3 and 2 of throttle
position sensor.
OK:
1
2
3
S05339
NG
Terminals
Throttle valve
Resistance
1 ∼ 2
2.5 ∼ 5.9 kΩ
3 ∼ 2
Fully closed
0.2 ∼ 6.3 kΩ
3 ∼ 2
Fully open
2.0 ∼ 10.2 kΩ
Replace throttle position sensor.
OK
Author:
Date:
476
DI–242
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminals VTA1 and E2 of ECM.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals VTA1 and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
ON
VTA1 (+)
E2 (–)
A02021
NG
Throttle valve
Voltage
Fully closed
0.3 ∼ 1.0 V
Fully open
2.7 ∼ 5.2 V
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and throttle position
sensor (VTA line) (See page IN–31).
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
5
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
ON
VC (+)
E2 (–)
A02022
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
Check for open in harness and connector
between ECM and sensor (VC line)
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
477
DI–243
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07L–06
DTC
P0121
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A”
Circuit Range/Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0120 (Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch "A" Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–239.
DTC No.
P0121
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
After vehicle speed has been exceeded 30 km/h (19 mph)
even once, output value of throttle position sensor is out of
applicable range while vehicle speed between 30 km/h (19
mph) and 0 km/h (0 mph)
(2 trip detection logic)
Throttle position sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0121) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Replace throttle position sensor.
Author:
Date:
478
DI–244
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07M–08
DTC
P0125
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop
Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three–way
catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three–way catalytic converter, the air–fuel
ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio.
The oxygen sensor has the characteristic whereby its output voltage changes suddenly in the vicinity of the
stoichiometric air–fuel ratio. This characteristic is used to detect the oxygen concentration in the exhaust
gas and provide feedback to the computer for control of the air–fuel ratio.
When the air–fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust increases and the oxygen
sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (small electromotive force: < 0.45 V).
When the air–fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas is reduced and the oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (large electromotive
force: > 0.45 V). The ECM judges by the electromotive force from the oxygen sensor whether the air–fuel
ratio is RICH or LEAN and controls the injection time accordingly. However, if malfunction of the oxygen sensor causes output of abnormal electromotive force, the ECM is unable to perform accurate air–fuel ratio control.
The heated oxygen sensors include a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is controlled by
the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is low) current flows to the
heater to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
Ideal Air–Fuel Mixture
Flange
Platinum Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platium Electrode
Output Voltage
Atmosphere
Heater
Coating(Ceramic)
Cover
Richer Air Fuel Ratio
Exhaust Gas
P21242 FI7210
DTC No.
P0125
Leaner
A00027
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up, heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, 2
sensor 1) output does not indicate RICH ( 0.45 V ) even
once when conditions (a), (b), (c) and (d) continue for at least
2 min.:
(a) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more
(b) Vehicle speed: 40 SPD and 100 km/h (25 SPD and
62 mph)
(c) Throttle valve does not fully closed
(d) 140 sec. or more after starting engine
Trouble Area
Fuel system
Injector
Ignition system
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
circuit
Heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
ECM
Author:
Date:
479
DI–245
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0125, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester to confirm voltage output
of the heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) from CURRENT DATA.
If voltage output of the heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) is less than 0.1 V, heated oxygen sensors
(bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit may be open or short.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
B+
Junction Connector
A
J36
B–W
3
EFI Relay
1
2
EFI
Engine
Room
J/B
2J 2
2A 1
1 F4
B–G
W–B
Fusible
Link
Block
FL
MAIN
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
Y–R
4
1
W
2
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
1
3
BR
B–Y
Battery
12
E10
OXL1
4
E10
HTL1
11
E10
OXR1
30
E11
E03
E1
E03
L–B
HTR
B
8
E8
OXS
E03
E1
1 4
A A
BR
BR
9
E8
P–B
EB
MREL
3
E10
3
2
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
8
E7
E1
4 BR
BR
1 F6
B
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
B
5 2C
5
J27
D
Junction Connector
B–Y
B–Y
A
A 2
3
BR
7 2K
9
II3
B–W
B–Y
B–Y
Junction Connector
B
B
B–Y
J27
J28
C
J35
HTS
E03
ED
EC
A07444
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If the vehicle run out fuel, the air–fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0125 will be recorded.
The MIL then comes on.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
480
DI–246
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0125) being output ?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value for
voltage output of heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the engine to normal operating temp.(above 75°C (169°F)).
CHECK:
Read voltage output of the heated oxygen sensors (bank 1,2 sensor 1) when engine is suddenly raced.
HINT:
Perform quick racing to 4,000 rpm 3 times using accelerator pedal.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) output a RICH signal
(0.45 V or more) at least once.
OK
Go to step 10.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
481
DI–247
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check whether misfire is occurred or not by monitoring DTC and data list.
NG
Perform troubleshooting for misfire
(See page DI–351).
OK
5
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
8
Check injector injection (See page SF–25)
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Author:
Date:
482
DI–248
DIAGNOSTICS
9
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace heated oxygen sensors
(bank 1, 2 sensor 1).
10
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–255).
Go
11
Is there DTC P0125 being output again ?
YES
Check and replace ECM
(See page IN–31).
NO
12
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past ?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
NO
DTC P0125 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
483
DI–249
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07M–09
DTC
P0125
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop
Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three–way
catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three–way catalytic converter, the air–fuel
ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio.
The A/F sensor has the characteristic that provides output voltage* approximately proportional to the existing
air–fuel ratio. The A/F sensor output voltage* is used to provide feedback for the ECM to control the air–fuel
ratio.
By the A/F sensor output, the ECM can determine the deviation amount from the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio
and control the proper injection time immediately. If the A/F sensor is malfunctioning, ECM is unable to perform accurate air–fuel ratio control.
The A/F sensor is equipped with a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is controlled by the
ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temp. of the exhaust gas is low), current flows to the heater
to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
*: The voltage value changes at the inside of the ECM only.
Platinum
Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platinum
Electrode
Heater
ECM Monitored
A/F Sensor Voltage
Atmosphere
(V)
4.0
3.8
3.6
3.4
3.2
3.0
2.8
2.6
2.4
Coating (Ceramic)
12
13 14
15 16 17 18 19
Air–Fuel Ratio
Cover
Exhaust Gas
A00477
DTC No.
P0125
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up, A/F sensor output* does not
change when conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for at least
1.5 min.
*: Output value changes at inside of ECM only.
(a) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more
(b) Vehicle speed: 40 ∼ 100 km/h (25 ∼ 62 mph)
(c) Throttle valve does not fully closed
(d) After starting engine 140 sec
Trouble Area
Fuel system
Injector
Ignition system
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
ECM
Author:
Date:
484
DI–250
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0125, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester to confirm voltage
output of heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) from CURRENT DATA.
The ECM controls the voltage of AFR, AFL, AFR and AFL terminals of ECM to the fixed voltage. Therefore, it is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
E03
HTS
A
BR
EC
J22
Junction
Connector
II1
B–G
EB
C J35
Junction
Connector
C J35
B
1 F4
5
3
EFI
1 F6
1 2A 5 2C
2
1
2 2J 7 2K
EFI Relay
W–B
B–W
Engine Room J/B
B–W
B–W
B
A
J36
1
2
A
4
3
2
B–Y
BR
BR
B
P–B
B–W
9
E8
OXS
8
E8
B–W
8
MREL
E7
E1
B+
E05
4
E10 HAFL
AFL–
3.0 V
4
3
2
1
A/F Sensor
(Bank 1, Sensor 2)
A/F Sensor
(Bank 2, Sensor 1)
E J27
B–Y
B J27
Junction
connector
B
B
B B
ES1
E04
to Analog–Digital
Converter
AFL+
3.3 V
HAFR
*L
*1B–W 12
E10
3
B–R
E10
*B–W
21
*1L
E10
20 AFR–
E10 3.0 V
*G
*1B–R
1
B B
2
A/F Sensor
(Bank 1, Sensor 1)
1
J24
Junction
Connector
4
3
11 AFR+
E10
3.3 V
*G
*1BR
ECM
to Analog–Digital
Converter
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
A/F HTR
1
A/F HTR Relay
L
2 1
2
5
3
*: TMC Made
*: TMMK Made
2
Engine Room
Battery
W–B
W
FL
2
FL
MAIN
2
2
1
Engine Room
A07445
Author:
Date:
485
DI–251
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0125) being output ?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
486
DI–252
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value for
voltage output of A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read voltage value of A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester, when you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of AFR,AFL terminal of ECM is 3.3 fixed and the AFR,AFL terminal is 3.0 V fixed.
Therefore, it is impossible to check the A/F sensor output voltage at the terminals (AFR,AFL/
AFR,AFL) of ECM.
OK:
Condition
Engine idling
E i idling
Engine
idli
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or move, and operate throttle valve
open and close
A/F Sensor Voltage value
Not
N t remains
i att 3.3.
3 3 V (*0.660
(*0
( 0.660
660 V)
Not remains at 3
3.8
8 V (*0.76
(*0 76 V) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (*0.56 V) or less
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) is
below 2.8 V (* 0.56 V), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) is above
3.8 V (* 0.76 V), it is normal.
If output voltage of A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V) even after performing
all the above conditions, A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit may be open.
If output voltage of A/F sensor remains at 3.8 V (* 0.76 V) or more, or 2.8 V (* 0.56 V) or less even after
performing all the above conditions, A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit may be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 10.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F
sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
487
DI–253
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check resistance of A/F sensor heaters (bank1, 2 sensor1) (See page SF–68).
NG
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
5
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–21).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
8
Check injector injection (See page SF–25).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Author:
Date:
488
DI–254
DIAGNOSTICS
9
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace
OK
Replace A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1).
10
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–340).
Go
11
Is there DTC P0125 being output again ?
YES
Check and replace ECM
(See page IN–31).
NO
12
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past ?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
YES
DTC P0125 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
489
DI–255
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07N–07
DTC
P0130
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1) (Except California Spec.)
DTC
P0150
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1) (Except California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control) on page DI–244.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0130
P0150
Voltage output of heated oxygen sensor remains at 0.4 V or
more, or 0.55 V or less, during idling after engine is warmed up
(2 trip detection logic)
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
HINT:
Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No.1. Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder
No.1. Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
The heated oxygen sensor’s output voltage and the short−term fuel trim value can be read using the
OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control) on page DI–244.
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle speed
50 ∼ 65 km/h
(31 ∼ 40 mph)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(4)
(3)
(5)
(1) (2)
1 ∼ 3 min.
1 min.
Time
A01666
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from normal mode to check mode (See page DI–197).
Start the engine and warm it up with all accessory switches OFF.
Drive the vehicle at 50 ∼ 65 km/h (31 ∼ 40 mph) for 1 ∼ 3 min. to warm up the heated oxygen sensor.
Let the engine idle for 1 min.
Perform steps (3) to (5) three times.
Author:
Date:
490
DI–256
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will light up during step (6).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction will not be possible.
If you do not have a TOYOTA hand–held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps
(3) to (6), then perform steps (3) to (6) again.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0130, P0150) being output ?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check the output voltage of heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1)
during idling.
PREPARATION:
Warm up the heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) during idling.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) output voltage:
Alternates repeatedly between less than 0.4 V and more than 0.55 V (See the following table).
P18349
OK
Go to step 8.
NG
Author:
Date:
491
DI–257
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
4
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace EGR system.
OK
6
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
Author:
Date:
492
DI–258
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check injector injection (See page SF–25).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace heated oxygen sensors
(bank1, 2 sensor1).
8
Perform confirmation driving pattern.
Go
9
Are there DTC P0130 and/or P0150 being output again ?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(see page DI–197).
YES
Check and replace ECM
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
493
DI–259
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI4DQ–01
DTC
P0133
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Slow
Response (Bank 1 Sensor 1) (Ex. CA Spec.)
DTC
P0153
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Slow
Response (Bank 2 Sensor 1) (Ex. CA Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control) on page DI–244.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0133
P0153
Response time for heated oxygen sensor’s voltage output to
change from rich to lean, or from lean to rich, is 1 sec. or more
during idling after engine is warmed up
(2 trip detection logic)
Heated oxygen sensor
Fuel trim malfunction
HINT:
Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No.1. Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder
No.1. Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0133, P0153) being output ?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
494
DI–260
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check the output voltage of heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1)
during idling.
PREPARATION:
Warm up the heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) during idling.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) output voltage:
Alternates repeatedly between less than 0.4 V and more than 0.55 V (See the following table).
P18349
OK
Go to step 8.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
4
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
495
DI–261
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace EGR system.
OK
6
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–1).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
7
Check injector injection (See page SF–25).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace heated oxygen sensors
(bank1, 2 sensor1).
8
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–255).
Go
Author:
Date:
496
DI–262
DIAGNOSTICS
9
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Are there DTC P0133 and/or P0153 being output again ?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(see page DI–197).
YES
Check and Replace ECM
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
497
DI–263
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07P–06
DTC
P0135
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 1) (EX. CA Spec.)
DTC
P0141
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0155
Heated Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction (Bank 2 Sensor 1) (EX. CA Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.)) on
page DI–244.
DTC No.
P0135
P0141
P0155
DTC Detecting Condition
When heater operates, heater current exceeds 2.35 A
(2 trip detection logic)
Heater current of 0.2 A or less when heater operates
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated
H t d oxygen sensor heater
h t
ECM
HINT:
Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No.1.
Bank 2 refers to the bank that does not include cylinder No.1.
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farther away from the engine body.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Except California Spec.))
on page DI–244.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
498
DI–264
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminals HTR, HTS, HTL of ECM connectors and body
ground.
ON
HTL (+)
HTR (+)
HTS (+)
A02023
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals HTR, HTS, HTL of the
ECM connectors and body ground.
HINT:
Connect terminal HTR to bank 1 sensor 1.
Connect terminal HTS to bank 1 sensor 2.
Connect terminal HTL to bank 2 sensor 1.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
2
Check resistance of heated oxygen sensor heater (See page SF–71).
NG
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
OK
Check and repair harness or connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and heated oxygen
sensor, and heated oxygen sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
499
DI–265
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07Q–06
DTC
P0136
Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control) on page DI–244.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0136
Voltage output of heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
remains at 0.4 V or more or 0.6*1 0.5*2 V or less when vehicle
is driven at 50 km/h (31 mph) or more after engine is warmed
up
*1: for California Spec.
*2: except California Spec.
(2 trip detection logic)
Heated oxygen sensor
HINT:
Bank 1 refers to the bank that includes cylinder No.1. Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farther away from the
engine body.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control) on page DI–244.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0136) being output ?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
500
DI–266
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check output voltage of heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the engine to normal operating temp.
CHECK:
Read voltage output of heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) when engine suddenly raced.
HINT:
Perform quick racing to 4,000 rpm 3 min. using accelerator pedal.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage: Alternates from 0.4 V or less to 0.6*1/0.5* 2 V or more.
*1: for California Spec.
*2: except California Spec.
OK
Check that each connector is properly
connected.
NG
Replace heated oxygen sensor
(bank 1 sensor 2).
Author:
Date:
501
DI–267
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07R–05
DTC
P0171
System too Lean (Fuel Trim)
(Only for California Spec.)
DTC
P0172
System too Rich (Fuel Trim)
(Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection time. Fuel trim
includes short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim.
Short–term fuel trim is the short–term fuel compensation used to maintain the air–fuel ratio at its ideal
theoretical value.
The signal from the A/F sensor is approximately proportional to the existing air–fuel ratio, and ECM comparing it with the ideal theoretical value, the ECM reduces fuel volume immediately if the air–fuel ratio is rich
and increases fuel volume if it is lean.
Long–term fuel trim compensates the deviation from the central value of the short–term fuel trim stored up
by each engine tolerance, and the deviation from the central value due to the passage of time and changes
of using environment.
If both the short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim exceed a certain value, it is detected as a malfunction
and the MIL lights up.
DTC No.
P0171
P0172
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When air fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on RICH side
(2 trip detection logic)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
When air fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on LEAN side
(2 trip detection logic)
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
Author:
Date:
502
DI–268
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
HINT:
When the DTC P0171 is recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the lean side. When DTC P0172 is
recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the rich side.
If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air–fuel ratio is lean and DTC P0171 is recorded. The MIL then comes
on.
If the total of the short–term fuel trim value and long–term fuel trim value is within ± 35 % (80°C (176°F)
or more), the system is functioning normally.
The A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) output voltage and the short–term fuel trim value can be read
using the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
The ECM controls the voltage of AFR, AFL, AFR and AFL terminals of ECM to the fixed voltage. Therefore, it is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensors (bank
1, 2 sensor 1) output voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check injector injection (See page SF–25).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
3
Check mass air flow meter and engine coolant temp. sensor
(See pages SF–35 and SF–63).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
503
DI–269
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for spark and ignition (See page IG–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–21).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, pressure regulator,
fuel pipe line and filter (See page SF–1).
OK
6
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
504
DI–270
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check the output voltage A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read voltage value of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) on the screen of OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester when you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of AFR, AFL terminal of ECM is 3.3 fixed AFR, AFL terminal is 3.0 V fixed. Therefore,
it is impossible to check the A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) output voltage at the terminals (AFR, AFL/
AFR, AFL) of ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25mph) or more, and operate throttle valve
open and close
Not remains at 3.30 V (*0.660 V)
Not remains at 3
3.8
8 V (*0
(*0.76
76 V) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (*0.56 V) or less
*: When you use the OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) is
below 2.8 V (*0.56 V), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is case that the output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) is above 3.8
V (*0.76 V), it is normal.
If output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) remains at 3.30 V (*0.660 V) even after performing
all the above conditions, A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) circuit may be open.
If output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) remains at 3.8 V (*0.76 V) or more, or 2.8 V (*0.56
V) or less even after performing all the above conditions, A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) circuit may
be short.
*: When you use the OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
Author:
Date:
505
DI–271
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1).
9
perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–340).
Go
10
Is there DTC P0171 or P0172 being output again ?
YES
Check and replace ECM
(See page IN–31).
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past ?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
YES
DTC P0171 or P0172 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
506
DI–272
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI4DR–01
DTC
P0171
System too Lean (Fuel Trim)
(Except California Spec.)
DTC
P0172
System too Rich (Fuel Trim)
(Except California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection time. Fuel trim
includes short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim.
Short–term fuel trim is the short–term fuel compensation used to maintain the air–fuel ratio at its ideal
theoretical value. The signal from the heated oxygen sensor indicates whether the air–fuel ratio is RICH or
LEAN compared to the ideal theoretical value, triggering a reduction in fuel volume if the air–fuel ratio is rich,
and an increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
Long–term fuel trim is overall fuel compensation carried out long–term to compensate for continual deviation
of the short–term fuel trim from the central value due to individual engine differences, wear over time and
changes in the usage environment.
If both the short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim are LEAN or RICH beyond a certain value, it is
detected as a malfunction and the MIL lights up.
DTC No.
P0171
P0172
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When air fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on RICH side
(2 trip detection logic)
Air intake (hose loose)
Fuel line pressure
Injector blockage
Heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Gas leakage on exhaust system
When air fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on LEAN side
(2 trip detection logic)
Fuel line pressure
Injector leak, blockage
Heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) malfunction
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Gas leakage on exhaust system
HINT:
When DTC P0171 is recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the LEAN side. When DTC P0172 is recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the RICH side.
If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air–fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0171 is recorded. The MIL then
comes on.
If the total of the short–term fuel trim value and long–term fuel trim value is within ± 35 % (80°C (176°F)
or more), the system is functioning normally.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
507
DI–273
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check injector injection (See page SF–21).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
3
Check mass air flow meter and engine coolant temp. sensor
(See pages SF–35 and SF–63).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
4
Check for spark and ignition (See page IG–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, pressure regulator,
fuel pipe line and filter.
OK
Author:
Date:
508
DI–274
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
7
Check the output voltage of heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) during
idling.
PREPARATION:
Warm up the heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Use the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to read the output voltage of the heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) during idling.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) output voltage:
Alternates repeatedly between less than 0.4 V and more than 0.55 V (See the Following table).
P18349
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
Author:
Date:
509
DI–275
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) (See page SF–71).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace heated oxygen sensors
(bank1, 2 sensor1).
9
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–255).
Go
10
Is there DTC P0171 or P0172 being output again ?
YES
Check and replace ECM.
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past ?
NO
Check for intermittent problems.
YES
DTC P0171 or P0172 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
510
DI–276
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07S–07
DTC
P0300
Random/Multiple Cylinder Misfire Detected
DTC
P0301
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0302
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0303
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0304
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0305
Cylinder 5 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0306
Cylinder 6 Misfire Detected
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Misfire: The ECM uses the crankshaft position sensor and camshaft position sensor to monitor changes in
the crankshaft rotation for each cylinder.
The ECM counts the number of times the engine speed change rate indicates that misfire has occurred.
When the misfire rate equals or exceeds the count indicating that the engine condition has deteriorated, the
MIL lights up.
If the misfire rate is high enough and the driving conditions will cause catalyst overheating, the MIL blinks
when misfiring occurs.
DTC No.
P0300
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
P0305
P0306
DTC Detecting Condition
Misfiring of random cylinders is detected during any
particular 200 or 1,000 revolutions
For any particular 200 revolutions for engine, misfiring is detected which can cause catalyst overheating
(This causes MIL to blink)
For any particular 1,000 revolutions of engine, misfiring is detected which causes a deterioration in emission
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel line pressure
EGR
Compression pressure
Valve clearance not to specification
Valve timing
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Open or short in engine wire
Connector connection
ECM
Author:
Date:
511
DI–277
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
HINT:
When the 2 or more codes for a misfiring cylinder are recorded repeatedly but no Random Misfire code is
recorded, it indicates that the misfires were detected and recorded at different times.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument
Panel J/B
3
1K
B–R
6
12
8 B–R
1C
II3
J18
Junction
Connector
Injector
1
B–R 2
B–R
L
5
E10 #10
1
R
6
#20
E10
1
Y
1 #30
E11
1
W
2
E11 #40
No. 1
B–R 2
Ignition
Switch
7
ECM
W–R
5
1K
No. 2
5
1B
W–R
B–R 2
4 2L
B–R 2
B–G
Fusible
Link
Block
1
1
F6
F4
AM2
No. 3
Engine
Room
J/B
N0.2
No. 4
1 R–L
B–R 2
No. 5
B–R 2
1 2A
1
G
No. 6
B
FL
MAIN
Battery
3
#50
E11
4 #60
E11
BR
21
E01
E11
BR
31 E02
E11
EC
A03319
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(1) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool.
(2) Record DTC and the freeze frame data.
(3) Use the TOYOTA hand–held tester to set to Check Mode. (See page DI–197)
(4) Drive the vehicle several times with the engine speed, load and its surrounding range shown with
ENGINE SPD, CALC LOAD in the freeze frame data or MISFIRE RPM, MISFIRE LOAD in the data list.
If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is simulated
the first time. Then repeat the simulation process again.
HINT:
In order to memorize DTC of misfire, it is necessary to drive around MISFIRE RPM, MISFIRE LOAD in the
data list for the following period of time.
Engine Speed
Time
Idling
3 minutes 30 seconds or more
1000 rpm
3 minutes or more
2000 rpm
1 minute 30 seconds or more
3000 rpm
1 minute or more
(5) Check whether there is misfire or not by monitoring DTC and the freeze frame data. After that, record
them.
(6) Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 5 seconds.
Author:
Date:
512
DI–278
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If is the case that DTC besides misfire is memorized simultaneously, first perform the troubleshooting
for them.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
data records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful
for determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
When the vehicle is brought to the workshop and the misfire is not occurred, misfire can be confirmed
by reproducing the condition or freeze frame data. Also, after finishing the repair, confirm that there
is no misfire. (See the confirmation driving pattern)
When either of SHORT FT #1, LONG FT #1, SHORT FT #2 or LONG FT #2 in the freeze frame data
is besides the range of ±20%, there is a possibility that the air–fuel ratio is inclining either to ”rich”
(–20% or less) or ”lean” (+20% or more).
When COOLANT TEMP in the freeze frame data is less than 80°C (176°F), there is a possibility or
misfire only during warming up.
In the case that misfire cannot be reproduced, the reason may be because of the driving with lack or
fuel, the use of improper fuel, a stain of ignition plug, and etc.
1
Check wire harness, connector and vacuum hose in engine room.
CHECK:
(a) Check the connection conditions of wire harness and connector.
(b) Check the disconnection, piping and break of vacuum hose.
NG
Repair or replace, then confirm that there is no
misfire (See the confirmation driving pattern).
OK
Author:
Date:
513
DI–279
DIAGNOSTICS
2
P25779
P23917
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check spark plug and spark of misfiring cylinder.
A00221
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ignition coil (See page IG–7).
(b) Remove the spark plug.
CHECK:
(a) Check spark plug type.
(b) Check for carbon deposits on electrode.
(c) Check electrode gap.
OK:
(a) Twin ground electrodes type.
Recommended spark plug:
ND PK20TR11
NGK BKR6EKPB–11
(b) No large carbon deposit present.
Not wet with gasoline or oil.
(c) Electrode gap:
Standerd: 1.0 – 1.1 mm (0.03937 – 0.043 in.).
Maximum: 1.3 mm (0.051 in.).
PREPARATION:
(a) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil, and connect the
ignition coil the connector.
(b) Disconnect injector connector.
(c) Hold the end about 12.5 mm (0.5 in.) from the ground.
CHECK:
Check if spark occurs while engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
To prevent excess fuel being injected from the
injectors during this test, don’t crank the engine for more
than 5 ∼ 10 sec. at a time.
OK:
Spark jumps across electrode gap.
NG
Replace or check ignition system
(See page IG–1).
OK
Author:
Date:
514
DI–280
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage of ECM terminal for injector of failed cylinder.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between applicable terminal of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
(+) (+) (+) (+) (+) (+)
#10 #20 #30 #40 #50 #60
A02024
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
INJECTOR SIGNAL WAVEFORM
With the engine idling, measure between terminals #10 ∼ #60 and E01 of ECM.
HINT:
The correct waveform is as shown.
(Magnification)
10 V
/Division
10 V
/Division
GND
GND
FI6588 FI6538
1 msec./Division (Idling)
Injection duration
100 msec./Division (Idling)
OK
A00064
Go to step 5.
NG
Author:
Date:
515
DI–281
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check resistance of injector of misfiring cylinder (See page SF–21).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between injector and ECM
(See page IN–31).
5
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–6).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
6
Check injector injection (See page SF–25).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
7
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace EGR system.
OK
Author:
Date:
516
DI–282
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check mass air flow meter and engine coolant temp. sensor
(See pages SF–35, SF–63).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check compression pressure, valve
clearance and valve timing.
Author:
Date:
517
DI–283
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07T–06
DTC
P0325
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P0330
Knock Sensor 2 Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect engine knocking.
This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it becomes deformed, which
occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded
to suppress it.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0325
No knock sensor 1 signal to ECM with engine speed between
2,000 rpm and 5,600 rpm.
Open or short in knock sensor 1 circuit
Knock sensor 1 (looseness)
ECM
P0330
No knock sensor 2 signal to ECM with engine speed between
2,000 rpm and 5,600 rpm.
Open or short in knock sensor 2 circuit
Knock sensor 2 (looseness)
ECM
If the ECM detects the above diagnosis conditions, it operates the fail–safe function in which the corrective
retard angle value is set to the maximum value.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Knock Sensor 1
(On right bank)
1
W
1
EC1
W
27 KNKR
E11
E1
Knock Sensor 2
(On left bank)
1
W
2
EC1
W
28
KNKL
E11
E1
A03315
Author:
Date:
518
DI–284
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
DTC P0325 is for the right bank knock sensor circuit. DTC P0330 is for the left bank knock sensor circuit.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and check knock sensor
circuit.
ECM
Knock Sensor
1
EC1
27 KNKR
1 1
E6
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Disconnect the wire to wire connector EC1.
(c) Connect the terminals of the disconnected EC1 male connector and EC1 female as follows.
28 KNKL
1
2 2
Male connector ↔ Female connector
E6
Terminal 1 ↔ Terminal 2
Male
Female
Connector Connector
Terminal 2 ↔ Terminal 1
(d)
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
(e) After the engine is warmed up, perform quick racing to
4,000 rpm three times.
CHECK:
Check the DTC.
RESULT:
EC1
Type I
DTC same as when vehicle brought in.
P0325 → P0325 or P0330 → P0330
Type II
DTC different to when vehicle brought in.
P0325 → P0330 or P0330 → P0325
A00304
Author:
Date:
519
DI–285
DIAGNOSTICS
0.5 V
/Division
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
With the engine racing (4,000 rpm), measure between
terminals KNKR, KNKL of the ECM connector and body
ground.
HINT:
The correct waveforms are as shown.
KNK Signal Waveforms
0V
5 msec./Division
200 mV
/Division
Spread the time on the horizontal axis, and confirm that
period of the wave is 141 µsec.
(Normal mode vibration frequency of knock sensor:
7.1 kHz)
0V
FI6510
FI6607
100 µsec./Division
HINT:
If normal mode vibration frequency is not 7.1 kHz, the sensor
is malfunctioning.
A00113
Type II
Go to step 3 .
Type I
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EC1 connector and
ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
520
DI–286
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EC1 connector and
knock sensor (See page IN–31).
HINT:
If DTC P0325 has changed to P0330, check the knock sensor circuit on the right bank side.
If DTC P0330 has changed to P0325, check the knock sensor circuit on the left bank side.
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace knock sensor.
Author:
Date:
521
DI–287
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07U–06
DTC
P0335
Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Crankshaft position sensor (NE signal) consists of a signal plate and pickup coil.
The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34
signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the G22 signals, and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE signals.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
P0335
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine
speed 600 rpm or more (2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position
osition sensor
Starter
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Camshaft Position Sensor
1
10
B–W
E11
2
L
1
B–R
B–R
2
BR
L
16
E10
24
E10
G22+
NE+
NE–
E2
Crankshaft Position Sensor
P25474
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Perform troubleshooting of DTC P0335 first. If no trouble is found, troubleshoot the following mechanical systems.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
522
DI–288
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check resistance of crankshaft position sensor (See page IG–12).
G22, NE Signal Waveforms
5V
/Division
G22
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
During cranking or idling, check between terminals G22+ and
NE–, NE and NE– of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The correct waveforms are as shown.
NE
20 msec./Division (Idling)
5V
/Division
G22
NE
FI7059
FI7060
10 msec./Division (Idling)
A00069
NG
Replace crankshaft position sensor.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and
crankshaft position sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
523
DI–289
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Inspect sensor installation and teeth of crankshaft timing pulley.
NG
Tighten the sensor.
Replace crankshaft timing pulley.
OK
Check and replace ECM
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
524
DI–290
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07V–06
DTC
P0340
Camshaft Position Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Camshaft position sensor (G22 signal) consist of a signal plate and pickup coil.
The G22 signal plate has one tooth, on its outer circumference and is mounted on the left bank camshafts.
When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the signal plate and the air gap on the pickup coil change,
causing fluctuations in the magnetic field and generating an electromotive force in the pickup coil.
The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34
signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the G22 signal
and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE signals.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
P0340
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine speed
600 rpm or more
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position
osition sensor
Starter
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–287 .
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check resistance of camshaft position sensor (See page IG–1).
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
Refer to DTC P0335 on page DI–287.
NG
Replace camshaft position sensor.
OK
Author:
Date:
525
DI–291
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and camshaft
position sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Inspect sensor installation and tooth of left bank camshaft timing pulley.
NG
Tighten the sensor.
Replace left bank camshaft timing pulley.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
526
DI–292
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI4DS–01
DTC
P0401
Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow
Insufficient Detected (Ex CA Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The EGR system recirculates exhaust gas, which is controlled to the proper quantity to suit the driving conditions, into the intake air mixture to slow down combustion, reduce the combustion temperature and reduce
NOx emissions.
The lift amount of EGR valve is controlled by the vacuum which is regulated by the Duty–VSV operated by
the ECM. The lift amount of EGR valve is detected by the EGR valve position sensor which is mounted on
the EGR valve and it provides feedback to the ECM to control the lift amount of EGR valve in response to
engine operating conditions.
Under the following conditions, EGR is cut to maintain driveability.
Before the engine is warmed up
During deceleration (throttle valve closed)
Light engine load (amount of intake air very small)
Engine speed over 4,000 rpm
Engine idling
ECM
Vacuum
Control
Valve
Throttle Valve
Mass Air Flow Meter
VSV
for
EGR
Intake Air
Chamber
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
EGR Valve
Position
Sensor
EGR Gas
Temp. Sensor
EGR Valve
Crankshaft Position Sensor
DTC No.
P0401
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up and run at 80 km/h (50 mph) for 3 to
5 min. EGR gas temperature sensor valve does not exceed
35°C (95°F) above ambient air temperature
(2 trip detection logic)
A00199
Trouble Area
EGR valve (stuck closed)
Open or short in EGR gas temp. sensor circuit
EGR gas temp. sensor
Open in VSV circuit for EGR
VSV for EGR
Vacuum control valve
Vacuum hose disconnected or blocked
ECM
Author:
Date:
527
DI–293
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room J/B
1
2A
From
FL MAIN
EFI
5
3
2
2J
B–Y
Junction
Connector
B
B
J27
J28
B–Y
9
II3
J20
Junction VSV
Connector for EGR
B–Y
B–Y
A
A1
Y–G
2
2
EFI Relay
1
1
B–W
2
Y
E10
22
3 W–G
W–B
C J35
Junction
Connector
C J35
2
E11
18
BR
E10
5V
EGLS
E2
5V
13
2 G–Y
1
VC
BR
EGR Valve
Position Sensor
B–W
E11
E01
7
2K
5
2C
ECM
18 EGR
E10
THG
BR
B+
EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
B–W
EB
8
MREL
E7
A07446
SYSTEM CHECK DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
(5)
(3)
70 ∼ 90 km/h
(43 ∼ 56 mph)
IG SW OFF
(4)
(2)
Idling
(1)
Time
Warmed up
3 ∼ 5 min.
3 min.
3 ∼ 5 min.
2 min.
S06906
Author:
Date:
528
DI–294
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Start and warm up the engine with all accessories switched OFF.
(3) Run the vehicle at 70 ∼ 90 km/h (43 ∼ 56 mph) for 3 min. or more.
(4) Idle the engine for about 2 min.
(5) Do steps (3) and (4) again.
(6) Stop at safe place and turn the ignition switch OFF.
(7) Do step (2) to (5) again.
(8) Check the READINESS TESTS mode on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
If COMPL is displayed and the MIL does not light up, the system is normal.
If INCMPL is displayed and the MIL does not light up, run the vehicle steps (2) to (6) from some times and
check it.
HINT:
INCMPL is displayed when either condition (a) or (b) exists.
(a) The system check is incomplete.
(b) There is a malfunction in the system.
If there is a malfunction in the system, the MIL light up after step (7) above is done.
(2trip detection logic)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
1
Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of EGR gas temperature.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the engine.
CHECK:
Read EGR gas temperature on TOYOTA hand–held tester during idling.
OK:
EGR gas temperature : 5°C (41°F) ∼ 150°C (302°F) (Not immediately after driving)
HINT:
If there is an open circuit, TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates 3.1°C (37.6°F).
If there is an short circuit, TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates 159.3°C (318.7°F).
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
Author:
Date:
529
DI–295
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open or short in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
EGR Gas Temp.
Sensor
1
5V
13
E10
18
THG
E10
E2
2
ON
ECM
EGR Gas Temp.
Sensor
1
5V
13
E10
18
E10
2
THG
E2
For open circuit
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the EGR gas temp. sensor connector.
(b) Connect the sensor wire harness terminals together.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read EGR gas temperature on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
EGR gas temperature : 159.3°C (318.7°F)
For short circuit
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the EGR gas temp. sensor connector.
CHECK:
Read EGR gas temperature on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
EGR gas temp. : 3.1°C (37.6°F)
OK
A00305
Confirm good connection at sensor.
If OK, check and replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
NG
Author:
Date:
530
DI–296
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open or short in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
13
1
E0
5V
THG
18
E107
E2
2
THG
E2
For open circuit
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Connect between terminals THG and E2 of the ECM connectors.
HINT:
EGR gas temp. sensor connector is disconnected. Before
checking, do a visual check and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector (See page IN–31).
CHECK:
Read EGR gas temperature on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
EGR gas temperature : 159.3°C (318.7°F)
A02048
ON
ECM
EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
5V
THG
E2
For short circuit
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Disconnect the E10 connector of ECM.
CHECK:
Read EGR gas temperature on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
EGR gas temperature: 3.1°C (37.6°F)
E10
A02043
OK
Repair or replace harness.
NG
Confirm connection at ECM.
If OK, check and replace ECM.
Author:
Date:
531
DI–297
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check connection and blockage of vacuum hose (See page EC–2).
NG
Repair or replace vacuum hose.
OK
5
Check VSV for EGR.
ON
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
Air
Air
E
E
F
BE6653
A02507
G
F
G
A02839
PREPARATION:
Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
CHECK:
Check operation VSV, when it is operated by the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
VSV is ON:
Air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe F and G.
VSV is OFF:
Air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe G.
OK
Go to step 8.
NG
6
Check operation of VSV for EGR (See page SF–56).
NG
Replace VSV for EGR.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector
between engine room J/B and ECM.
Author:
Date:
532
DI–298
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
8
Check EGR valve.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from EGR valve.
(b) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Check whether the engine stall when apply vacuum to EGR
valve.
OK:
Engine runs rough or stall.
Vacuum
EGR Valve
S05410
NG
Repair or replace EGR valve.
OK
9
Check vacuum control valve (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace vacuum control valve.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
533
DI–299
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
1
Check resistance of EGR gas temp. sensor.
EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
Connector
P23871
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the EGR gas temp. sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals of the EGR gas temp.
sensor connector.
OK:
Resistance: 2.5 kΩ ∼ 600 kΩ
(Not immediately after driving)
HINT:
If there is open circuit, ohmmeter indicates 720 kΩ or more.
If there is short circuit, ohmmeter indicates 200 Ω or less.
NG
Replace EGR gas temp. sensor.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EGR gas temp.
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check connection and blockage of vacuum hose (See page EC–2).
NG
Repair or replace vacuum hose.
OK
Author:
Date:
534
DI–300
DIAGNOSTICS
4
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check VSV for EGR.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Disconnect the E11 connector of ECM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check VSV function.
(1) Connect between terminal EGR of the ECM and
body ground (VSV is ON).
(2) Disconnect between terminal EGR of the ECM and
body ground (VSV is OFF).
OK:
(1) VSV is ON:
Air from pipe E flows out through pipe F.
(2) VSV is OFF:
Air from pipe E flows out through pipe G.
ON
E11
EGR
ON
OFF
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
Air
Air
E
F
–
E
G
F
G
A02047
OK
Go to step 7.
NG
5
Check operation of VSV for EGR (See page SF–56).
NG
Replace VSV for EGR.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector
between engine room J/B and ECM
(See page IN–31).
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
535
DI–301
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check EGR valve.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from EGR valve.
(b) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Check whether the engine stall when apply vacuum to EGR
valve.
OK:
Engine runs rough or stall.
Vacuum
EGR Valve
S05410
NG
Repair or replace EGR valve.
OK
8
Check vacuum control valve (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace vacuum control valve.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
536
DI–302
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07X–06
DTC
P0402
Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow
Excessive Detected (Ex CA Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0401 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient Detected) on page DI–292.
DTC No.
P0402
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When EGR cut–off, lift amount of EGR valve is
2.6 mm (0.1 in.) or more
(2 trip detection logic)
EGR valve stuck open
VSV for EGR open malfunction
Short in VSV circuit for EGR
Open or short in EGR valve position sensor circuit
EGR valve position sensor
ECM
See DTC P0401 (Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Insufficient Detected) on See page DI–292 for SYSTEM CHECK DRIVING PATTERN and WIRING DIAGRAM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
1
Check connection and blockage of vacuum hose.
NG
Repair or replace vacuum hose.
OK
2
Check VSV for EGR (See page DI–292, step 5).
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
Author:
Date:
537
DI–303
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check operation of VSV for EGR (See page SF–56).
NG
Replace VSV for EGR.
OK
Check for short in harness between VSV for
EGR and ECM (See page IN–31).
4
Check EGR valve (See page EC–11).
NG
Repair or replace EGR valve.
OK
5
Check EGR valve position sensor (See page DI–358).
NG
Repair or replace EGR valve position sensor or
harness.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OBDII scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
1
Check connection and blockage of vacuum hose.
NG
Repair or replace vacuum hose.
OK
Author:
Date:
538
DI–304
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check VSV for EGR (See page DI–292, step 5).
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
3
Check operation of VSV for EGR (See page SF–56).
NG
Replace VSV for EGR.
OK
Check for short in harness between VSV for
EGR and ECM (See page IN–31).
4
Check EGR valve (See page EC–11).
NG
Repair or replace EGR valve.
OK
5
Check EGR valve position sensor (See page DI–358).
NG
Repair or replace EGR valve position sensor or
harness.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
539
DI–305
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI07Y–06
DTC
P0420
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Except California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM compares the waveform of the oxygen sensor located before the catalyst with the waveform of
the oxygen sensor located after the catalyst to determine whether or not catalyst performance has deteriorated.
Air–fuel ratio feedback compensation keeps the waveform of the oxygen sensor before the catalyst repeatedly changing back and forth from rich to lean.
If the catalyst is functioning normally, the waveform of the oxygen sensor after the catalyst switches back
and forth between rich and lean much more slowly than the waveform of the oxygen sensor before the catalyst.
But when both waveforms change at a similar rate, it indicates that catalyst performance has deteriorated.
Waveform of Oxygen Sensor
before Catalyst
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of Oxygen Sensor
after Catalyst
FI7081
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0420
After engine and catalyst are warmed up, and while vehicle is
driven within set vehicle and engine speed range, waveforms
of heated oxygen sensors (bank 1 sensor 1, 2) have the same
amplitude
(2 trip detection logic)
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
Heated oxygen sensor
CONFIRMATION ENGINE RACING PATTERN
Engine Speed
(c)
2,500 ∼ 3,000 rpm
Idling
IG SW OFF
(d)
(b)
(a)
Warmed up
3 min. or so
Check
Time
FI7132
Author:
Date:
540
DI–306
DIAGNOSTICS
(a)
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3, or connect the probe of the oscilloscope between
terminals OXR1, OXL1, OXS and E1 of the ECM connector.
Start engine and warm it up with all accessories switched OFF until water temp. is stable.
Race the engine at 2,500 ∼ 3,000 rpm for about 3 min.
After confirming that the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor, bank 1, 2 sensor 1 (OXR1, OXL1),
oscillate around 0.5 V during feedback to the ECM, check the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor,
bank 1 sensor 2 (OXS).
(b)
(c)
(d)
OX Signal Waveform (Oscilloscope)
1V
0V
200 m sec./Division
HINT:
If there is a malfunction in the system, the waveform of the
heated oxygen sensor, bank 1 sensor 2 (OXS), is almost the
same as that of the heated oxygen sensor, bank 1, 2 sensor 1
(OXR1, OXL1), on the left.
There are some cases where, even though a malfunction
exists, the MIL may either light up or not light up.
FI6514
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held theater or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich,
etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0420) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
541
DI–307
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check heated oxygen sensor (bank 1, sensor 1) (See page DI–255).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
4
Check heated oxygen sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 2) (See page DI–265).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace three–way catalytic converter.
Author:
Date:
542
DI–308
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI1K4–03
DTC
P0420
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM observes the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor located behind the catalyst to determine
whether the catalyst is performance has deteriorated.
If the catalyst is functioning normally, the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor located behind the catalyst
switches back and forth between rich and lean much more slowly.
When the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor located behind the catalyst alternates flatteringly between
rich and lean, it indicates that catalyst performance has deteriorated.
Waveform of
A/F Sensor
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of Heated Oxygen
Sensor Behind Catalyst
Abnormal Catalyst
A01674
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0420
After engine and catalyst are warmed up, and while vehicle is
driven within set vehicle and engine speed range, waveform of
heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) alternates flatteringly
between rich and lean
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Three–way catalytic converter
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor
(bank 1 sensor 2) circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Open or short in A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
Author:
Date:
543
DI–309
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
CONFIRMATION ENGINE RACING PATTERN
Engine Speed
3,000 rpm
(c)
(d)
2,000 rpm
Idling
IG SW OFF
(b)
(a)
3 min. or so
Warmed up
Time
2 sec. 2 sec.
Check
A00479
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Start engine and warm it up with all accessories switched OFF until water temp. is stable.
Race the engine at 2,500 ∼ 3,000 rpm for about 3 min.
When racing the engine at 3,000 rpm for 2 sec. and 2,000 rpm for 2 sec. alternately, check the waveform of the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0420) being output ?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
544
DI–310
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) (See page DI–255).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
4
Check heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) (See page DI–265).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace three–way catalytic converter.
Author:
Date:
545
DI–311
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI4DT–01
DTC
P0440
Evaporative Emission Control System
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor are used to detect abnormalities in the evaporative emission control system.
The ECM decides whether there is an abnormality in the evaporative emission control system based on the
vapor pressure sensor signal.
DTC P0440 is recorded by the ECM when evaporative emissions leak from the components within the dotted
line in fig. 1 below, or when the vapor pressure sensor malfunctions.
fig. 1
ECM
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
VSV
for EVAP
(6)
(7)
(1)
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Over Fill
(2) Check Valve
(4)
(5)
(8)
(9)
(3)
Charcoal Canister
Fuel Tank
A01652
DTC No.
P0440
DTC Detecting Condition
Fuel tank pressure is atmospheric pressure after vehicle is
driven for 20 min. (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Vapor pressure sensor
Fuel tank cap incorrectly installed
Fuel tank cap cracked or damaged
Vacuum hose cracked, holed, blocked, damaged or
disconnected ((1) or (2) in fig. 1)
Hose or tube cracked, holed, damaged or loose seal
((3) in fig. 1)
Fuel tank cracked, holed or damaged
Charcoal canister cracked, holed or damaged
Fuel tank over fill check valve cracked or damaged
Author:
Date:
546
DI–312
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
5V
Vapor Pressure Sensor
2
FL MAIN
From
1
2A
5
2C
2
2
ID1
BR
3
II1
Y
1
IA1
L–R
1
Engine Rom J/B
5
3
EFI
5
ID1
Y
3
2
E10
Y
L–R
4
II1
BR
BR
17
E7
PTNK
18
E10
E2
J23
Junction
Junction
Connector
Connector VSV for EVAP
2
B B–Y 9
7
B
B–Y
B–Y
LG
B–Y
J27
2J
J28
II3
E10
A
A 1
2
E J28
7
2K
B–W
1
EFI Relay
VC
E1
EVP1
E01
ID1 10
B–Y 1
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
W–B
C J35
Junction
Connector
C J35
2
V
2
ID1
V
9
E7
TPC
E01
B+
EB
B–W
8
E7
MREL
A07447
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If DTCs P0441, P0446, P0450 or P0451 is output after DTC P0440, first troubleshoot DTCs P0441,
P0446, P0450 or P0451. If no malfunction is detected, troubleshoot DTC P0440 next.
Ask the customer whether, after the MIL came on, the customer found the fuel tank cap loose and tightened it. Also ask the customer whether the fuel tank cap was loose when refuelling. If the fuel tank cap
was not loose, it was the cause of the DTC. If the fuel tank cap was not loose or if the customer was
not sure if it was loose, troubleshoot according to the following procedure.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
When the ENGINE RUN TIME in the freeze frame data is less than 200 seconds, carefully check the
VSV for EVAP, charcoal canister and vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
547
DI–313
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check whether hose close to fuel tank have been modified, and check whether
there are signs of any accident near fuel tank or charcoal canister.
CHECK:
Check for cracks, deformation and loose connection of these
parts:
Fuel tank
Charcoal canister
Fuel tank filler pipe
Hoses and tubes around fuel tank and charcoal
canister
A01653
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check that fuel tank cap is TOYOTA genuine parts.
NG
Replace to TOYOTA genuine parts.
OK
3
Check that fuel tank cap is correctly installed.
NG
Correctly install fuel tank cap.
OK
4
Check fuel tank cap (See page EC–6).
NG
Replace fuel tank cap.
OK
Author:
Date:
548
DI–314
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check filler neck for damage.
PREPARATION:
Remove the fuel tank cap.
CHECK:
Visually inspect the filler neck for damage.
NG
Replace filler pipe.
OK
6
Check vacuum hoses between vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor
pressure sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure sensor and charcoal canister
(See page EC–3 , SF–62 and EC–6).
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole and damage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
7
Check hose and tube between fuel tank and charcoal canister.
CHECK:
(a) Check for proper connection of the fuel tank and fuel evap pipe (See page SF–1), fuel evap pipe and
fuel tube under the floor, fuel tube under the floor and charcoal canister.
(b) Check the hose and tube for cracks, hole and damage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
549
DI–315
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check charcoal canister for cracks, hole and damage (See page EC–6).
NG
Replace charcoal canister.
OK
9
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
CHECK:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
ON
VC (+)
E2 (–)
A02022
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
Author:
Date:
550
DI–316
DIAGNOSTICS
10
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connectors.
ON
E2 (–)
(1)
PTNK (+)
(2)
Vacuum
A02025
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of the ECM
connectors.
(1) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor.
(2) Using the MITYVAC (Hand–Held Vacuum Pump),
apply a vacuum of 4.0 kPa (30 mmHg, 1.18 in.Hg)
to the vapor pressure sensor.
NOTICE:
The vacuum applied to the vapor pressure sensor must be
less than 66.7 kPa (500 mmHg, 19.7 in.Hg).
OK:
(1) Voltage: 2.9 ∼ 3.7 V
(2) Voltage: 0.5 V or less
OK
Go to step 12.
NG
11
Check for open and short in harness and connector between vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
551
DI–317
DIAGNOSTICS
12
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check fuell tank and fuel tank over fill check valve for cracks and damage.
(See page EC–2)
NG
Replace fuel tank or fuel tank over fill check
valve.
OK
It is likely that vehicle user did not properly close fuel tank cap.
Please explain to customer how to properly install fuel tank cap.
Author:
Date:
552
DI–318
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI080–07
DTC
P0441
Evaporative Emission Control System
Incorrect Purge Flow
DTC
P0446
Evaporative Emission Control System Vent
Control Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor are used to detect abnormalities in the evaporative emission control system.
The ECM decides whether there is an abnormality in the evaporative emission control system based on the
vapor pressure sensor signal.
DTCs P0441 and P0446 are recorded by the ECM when evaporative emissions leak from the components
within the dotted line in fig. 1 below, or when there is a malfunction in either the VSV for EVAP, the VSV for
vapor pressure sensor, or in the vapor pressure sensor itself.
fig. 1
ECM
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
(7)
VSV
for EVAP
(1)
(6)
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
(4)
(2)
(5)
Fuel Tank Over
Fill Check Valve
(9)
(8)
(3)
Charcoal Canister
Fuel Tank
A01654
Author:
Date:
553
DI–319
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Pressure in charcoal canister does not drop during purge control (2 trip detection logic)
P0441
During purge cut–off, pressure in charcoal canister is very low
compared with atmospheric pressure
(2 trip detection logic)
When VSV for vapor pressure sensor is OFF, ECM judges that
there is no continuity between vapor pressure sensor and
charcoal canister (2 trip detection logic)
P0446
When VSV for vapor pressure sensor is ON, ECM judges that
there is no continuity between vapor pressure sensor and fuel
tank (2 trip detection logic)
After purge cut off operates, pressure in charcoal canister is
maintained at atmospheric pressure
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in VSV circuit for EVAP
Open or short in VSV circuit for vapor pressure sensor
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
VSV for EVAP
VSV for vapor pressure sensor
or pressure
ressure sensor
Va
Vapor
Vacuum hose cracks, holed blocked, damaged or
disconnected ((1), (4), (5),(6) and (7) in fig. 1)
Charcoal canister cracks, holed or damaged
Fuel
F l tank
t k over fill check
h k valve
l cracked
k d or damaged
d
d
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0440 (Evaporative Emission Control System Malfunction) on page DI–311 for the WIRING
DIAGRAM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0441, P0446, P0450 or P0451 is output after DTC P0440, first troubleshoot DTCs P0441,
P0446, P0450 or P0451. If no malfunction is detected, troubleshoot DTC P0440 next.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
When the ENGINE RUN TIME in the freeze frame data is less than 200 seconds, carefully check the
VSV for EVAP, charcoal canister and vapor pressure sensor.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
1
Check VSV connector for EVAP, VSV connector for vapor pressure sensor and
vapor pressure sensor connector for looseness and disconnection.
NG
Repair or connect VSV or sensor connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
554
DI–320
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check vacuum hoses (1), (4), (5), (6), (7) and (8) on page DI–311).
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole, damage and blockage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–311, step 9).
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
4
Check voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connectors
(See page DI–311, step 10).
OK
Go to step 6.
NG
5
Check for open and short in harness and connector between vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
555
DI–321
DIAGNOSTICS
6
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check purge flow.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
(c) Disconnect from the charcoal canister the vacuum hose
to the VSV for EVAP.
(d) Start the engine.
CHECK:
When the VSV for EVAP is operated by the TOYOTA
hand–held tester, check whether the disconnected hose applies suction to your finger.
OK:
VSV is ON:
Disconnected hose applies suction to your finger.
VSV is OFF:
Disconnected hose applies no suction to your finger.
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
S04610
S04609
–
A00230
OK
Go to step 10.
NG
7
Check vacuum hoses between intake manifold and VSV for EVAP, and VSV for
EVAP and charcoal canister.
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole, damage and blockage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
556
DI–322
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check operation of VSV for EVAP (See page SF–58).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
Replace VSV and charcoal canister, and then clean the vacuum hoses between throttle body and
VSV for EVAP, and VSV for EVAP and charcoal canister.
9
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and VSV for EVAP, VSV for EVAP and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
557
DI–323
DIAGNOSTICS
10
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check VSV for vapor pressure sensor.
ON
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
Air
Air
E
E
G
G
F
F
BE6653
S00558 S00557
A00474
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
CHECK:
Check the VSV operation when it is operated by TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
VSV is ON:
Air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe F.
VSV is OFF:
Air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe G.
OK
Go to step 13.
NG
11
Check operation of VSV for vapor pressure sensor (See page SF–62).
OK
Go to step 12.
NG
Replace VSV and charcoal canister, and then clean the vacuum hoses between charcoal canister
and VSV for vapor pressure sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure sensor and vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
558
DI–324
DIAGNOSTICS
12
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and VSV for vapor pressure sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
13
When VSV connector for vapor pressure sensor is disconnected and VSV for
EVAP is ON, measure voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connectors.
VSV Connector
for Vapor Pressure
Sensor
PTNK (+)
E2 (–)
A07146
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Disconnect the VSV connector for vapor pressure sensor.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
(d) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM
connectors. Using the TOYOTA hand–held tester when VSV for
EVAP is ON, .
OK:
Voltage: 2.0 V or less
OK
Go to step 15.
NG
Author:
Date:
559
DI–325
DIAGNOSTICS
14
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check vacuum hoses between charcoal canister and VSV for vapor pressure
sensor, and vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor.
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole, damage and blockage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
15
Engine
Check charcoal canister.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Remove the fuel tank cap.
(c) Disconnect the VSV connector for vapor pressure sensor.
(d) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
(e) Start the engine.
(f)
VSV for EVAP is ON by the TOYOTA hand–held tester
and remains on for 5 sec.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connectors 5 sec. after switching VSV for EVAP from ON to OFF.
Start
Stop
VSV for
ON
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
OFF
VSV for ON
EVAP OFF
5 sec.
Measure Voltage
E2 (–)
PTNK (+)
OK:
Voltage: 2.5 V or less
NG
Replace charcoal canister.
A07147
OK
Author:
Date:
560
DI–326
DIAGNOSTICS
16
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Remove charcoal canister and check it (See page EC–6).
NG
Replace charcoal canister.
OK
17
Check fuel tank over fill check valve (See page EC–2).
NG
Replace fuel tank over fill check valve or fuel
tank.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
1
Check VSV connector for EVAP, VSV connector for vapor pressure sensor and
vapor pressure sensor connector for looseness and disconnection.
NG
Repair or connect VSV or sensor connector.
OK
2
Check vacuum hoses (1), (4), (5), (6) (7) and (8) on Page DI–311).
CHECK:
(a) Check that the vacuum hose is connected correctly.
(b) Check the vacuum hose for looseness and disconnection.
(c) Check the vacuum hose for cracks, hole, damage and blockage.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Author:
Date:
561
DI–327
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–311, step 9).
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
4
Check voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connectors
(See page DI–311, step 10).
OK
Go to step 6.
NG
5
Check for open and short in harness and connector between vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
562
DI–328
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check VSV for EVAP.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check VSV function.
(1) Connect between terminal EVA1 of the ECM
connector and body ground (ON).
(2) Disconnect between terminal EVP of the ECM connector and body ground (OFF).
OK:
(1) VSV is ON:
Air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe F.
(2) VSV is OFF:
Air does not flow from pipe E to pipe F.
ON
OFF
ON
EVA1
VSV is ON
Air
VSV is OFF
Air
E
F
E
F
A07148
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
7
Check operation of VSV for EVAP (See page SF–58).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
Replace VSV and charcoal canister, and then clean the vacuum hoses between throttle body and
VSV for EVAP, and VSV for EVAP and charcoal canister.
Author:
Date:
563
DI–329
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and VSV for EVAP and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
9
Check VSV for vapor pressure sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check VSV function.
(1) Connect between terminal TPC of the ECM connector and body ground (ON).
(2) Disconnect between terminal TPC of the ECM
connector and body ground (OFF).
OK:
(1) VSV is ON:
Air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe F.
(2) VSV is OFF:
Air from pipe E flows out through pipe G.
ON
TPC
OFF
ON
VSV is ON
Air
E
G
F
VSV is OFF
Air
E
F
G
A07149
OK
Check and replace charcoal canister
(See page EC–6).
NG
Author:
Date:
564
DI–330
DIAGNOSTICS
10
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check operation of VSV for vapor pressure sensor (See page SF–62).
OK
Go to step 11.
NG
Replace VSV and clean the vacuum hoses between charcoal canister and VSV for vapor pressure
sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure sensor and vapor pressure sensor, and then check the charcoal canister.
11
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and VSV for vapor pressure sensor, and VSV for vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
12
Check the fuel tank over fill check valve (See page EC–6).
NG
Replace fuel tank over fill check valve or fuel
tank.
OK
Check and replace charcoal canister
(See page EC–6).
Author:
Date:
565
DI–331
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI1K5–03
DTC
P0450
Evaporative Emission Control System
Pressure Sensor Malfunction
DTC
P0451
Evaporative Emission Control System
Pressure Sensor Range/Performance
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vapor pressure sensor and VSV for vapor pressure sensor are used to detect abnormalities in the evaporative emission control system.
The ECM decides whether there is an abnormality in the evaporative emission control system based on the
vapor pressure sensor signal.
DTC P0450 or p0451 is recorded by the ECM when the vapor pressure sensor malfunction.
ECM
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
VSV
for EVAP
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Over
Fill Check Valve
Charcoal Canister
Fuel Tank
A01655
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0450
10 seconds or more after engine starting condition (a) or (b)
continues for 7 seconds or more:
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vapor Pressure Sensor Value < –3.5 kPa (–26 mmHg,
–1.0 in.Hg)
(b) Vapor Pressure Sensor Value 1.5 kPa (15 mmHg,
0.4 in.Hg)
P451
Vapor pressure sensor output extremely changes under
conditions of (a), (b) and (c):
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 0 km/h (0 mph)
(b) Engine speed: Idling
(c) VSV for vapor pressure sensor is ON.
Trouble Area
Open or short in vapor pressure sensor circuit
Vapor
V
pressure sensor
ECM
Author:
Date:
566
DI–332
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0440 (Evaporative Emission Control Malfunction) on page DI–311.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0441, P0446, P0450 or P0451 is output after DTC P0440, first troubleshoot DTCs P0441,
P0446 ,P0450 or P0451. If no malfunction is detected, troubleshoot DTC P0440 next.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
When the ENGINE RUN TIME in the freeze frame data is less than 200 seconds, carefully check the
VSV for EVAP, charcoal canister and vapor pressure sensor.
1
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector
(See page DI–311, step 9).
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminals PTNK and E2 of ECM connectors
(See page DI–311, step 10).
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between vapor pressure
sensor and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace vapor pressure sensor.
Author:
Date:
567
DI–333
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI082–06
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft, which is rotated
by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear. After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the
ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
4–Pulse
4–Pulse
Vehicle Speed
Sensor
Combination
Meter
ECM
Transaxle
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Q00515 Q00514
A00223
DTC No.
P0500
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No vehicle speed sensor signal to ECM under conditions (a)
and (b):
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Park/neutral position switch is OFF
(b) Vehicle is being driven
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Combination
Meter
14
C9
V–W
3
IG3
J15
Junction
Connector
V–W
5V
V–W
B
B
22 SPD
E8
A03316
Author:
Date:
568
DI–334
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check operation of speedometer.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the speedometer in the combination meter is normal.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedmeter display is normal.
NG
Check speedmeter circuit.
OK
2
Check for short in harness and connector between terminal SPD of ECM and
body ground (See page IN–31).
E8
SPD
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Disconnect the E8 connector of ECM.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal SPD of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
No continuity (1 MΩ or higher)
A02030
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
569
DI–335
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
E8
SPD (+)
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Disconnect the E8 connector of ECM.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal SPD of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
A02029
NG
Check for open in harness and connector
between junction connector (J15) and ECM
(See page IN–31).
OK
4
Check for open in harness and connector between junction connector (J14) and
combination meter (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
570
DI–336
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI083–06
DTC
P0505
Idle Control System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is located in front of the intake air chamber and intake air bypassing the throttle valve is
directed to the IAC valve through a passage.
In this way the intake air volume bypassing the throttle valve is
regulated, controlling the engine speed.
The ECM operates only the IAC valve to perform idle–up and
provide feedback for the target idling speed.
Intake Air Chamber
Throttle Valve
From
Air
Cleaner
Signal
ECM
IAC Valve
Valve
To Cylinders
P01559
DTC No.
P0505
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
IAC valve is stuck or closed
Open or short in IAC valve circuit
Open or short in A/C signal circuit
Air intake (hose loose)
ECM
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from target speed
(2 trip detection logic)
WIRING DIAGRAM
B–Y
ECM
J16
IAC Valve 16
Junction
RSO
R–W
E11
Connector
1
B–Y
E01
A2
15
RSC
Y–B
A
E11
3
E01
9 II3
From
Battery
FL
MAIN
B–G
Fusible
Link
1 Block 1
F4
Engine Room J/B
1
F6 B 2A
W–B
5
2C
EFI
5
3
1
2
EFI Relay
2
2J
7
2K
B B–Y
B J28 B
B–Y
Junction
J27
Connector
A
C
B–W
B–W 8
J36
J35
E7
Junction
Connector
B+
MREL
EC
A07448
Author:
Date:
571
DI–337
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check engine idle speed.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Switch off all accessories.
(c) Switch off air conditioning.
(d) Shift transmission into ”N” or neutral position.
(e) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 on the vehicle.
(f)
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC3.
CHECK:
Check the difference of engine speed between the ones less than 5 sec. and more than 5 sec. after connecting terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
OK:
Difference of engine speed: More than 100 rpm
OK
Go to step 6.
NG
Author:
Date:
572
DI–338
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminals RSO, RSC of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Disconnect the E11 connector of ECM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals RSO, RSC of the ECM
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
E11
RSO (+)
OK
RSC (+)
Go to step 4.
A02031
NG
3
Check IAC valve (See page SF–46).
NG
Replace IAC valve.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine room J/B and IAC valve, IAC
valve and ECM (See page IN–31).
4
Check operation of IAC valve (See page SF–42).
NG
Repair or replace IAC valve.
OK
Author:
Date:
573
DI–339
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check the blockage of IAC valve and the passage to bypass the throttle valve.
NG
Repair or replace IAC valve.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
6
Check for A/C signal circuit (See page AC–88).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check air induction system
(See page SF–1).
Author:
Date:
574
DI–340
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI1K6–03
DTC
P1130
A/F Sensor Circuit Range/Performance Malfunction (Only for California Spec.)
DTC
P1150
A/F Sensor Circuit Range/Performance Malfunction (Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.)) on Page
DI–249.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Voltage output* of A/F sensor remains at 3.8 V or more, or
2.8 V or less, during engine running after engine is warmed
up (2 trip detection logic)
*: Output value changes at inside of ECM only.
P1130
P1150
Voltage output* of A/F sensor does not change from 3.30 V,
during engine running after engine is warmed up
(2 trip detection logic)
*: Output value changes at inside of ECM only.
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
ECM
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
(2 trip detection logic)
HINT:
After confirming DTC P1130 or P01150, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm voltage output of A/F sensor (AFS B1 S1/O2S B1 S1) from ”CURRENT DATA”.
The A/F sensor’s output voltage and the short–term fuel value can be read using the OBD II scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
The ECM controls the voltage of AFR/AFL and AFR/AFL terminals of ECM to the fixed voltage.
Therefore, it is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–249.
Author:
Date:
575
DI–341
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
60 ∼ 120 km/h
(38 ∼ 75 mph)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(4)
(3)
(1)(2)
3 ∼ 5 min.
Time
A00364
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from normal mode to check mode (See page DI–197).
(c) Start the engine and warm it up with all accessory switches OFF.
(d) Drive the vehicle at 60 ∼ 120 km/h (38 ∼ 75 mph) and engine speed at 1,600 ∼ 3,200 rpm for 3 ∼ 5 min.
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will light up during step (4).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction will not be possible.
If you do not have a TOYOTA hand–held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps
(3) and (4), then perform steps (3) and (4) again.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P1130 is displayed, check Bank 1 Sensor 1 circuit.
If DTC P1150 is displayed, check Bank 2 Sensor 1 circuit.
Read frame freeze data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P1130, P1150) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
576
DI–342
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester and read value for
voltage output of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read voltage of A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester when you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of AFR and AFL terminals of ECM is fixed at 3.3 V and the voltage of AFR and AFL
terminals is fixed at 3.0 V. Therefore, it is impossible to check the A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) output
voltage at the terminals (AFR, AFL/AFR, AFL) of ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle
valve open and close.
Not remains at 3.30 V (*0.660 V)
Not remains at 3.8
3 8 V (*0.76
(*0 76 V) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (*0.56 V) or less
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) is
below 2.8 V (* 0.56 V), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) is above 3.8
V (* 0.76 V), it is normal.
If output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V) even after performing
all the above conditions, A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) circuit may be open.
If output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) remains at 3.8 V (* 0.76V) or more, or 2.8 V (*0.56
V) or less even after performing all the above conditions, A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) circuit may
be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
Author:
Date:
577
DI–343
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
4
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (See page SF–68).
NG
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
5
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–21).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
Author:
Date:
578
DI–344
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check injector injection (See page SF–25).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1).
9
Perform confirmation driving pattern.
Go
10
Are there DTC P1130 and/or P1150 being output again ?
YES
Check and replace ECM
(See page IN–31.).
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past ?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
YES
DTC P1130 and /or P1150 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
579
DI–345
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI1K7–03
DTC
P1133
A/F Sensor Circuit Response Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1) (Only for California Spec.)
DTC
P1153
A/F Sensor Circuit Response Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1) (Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–249.
DTC No.
P1133
P1155
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
After engine is warmed up and during vehicle driving at
engine speed 1,400 rpm or more and vehicle speed 60
km/h (38 mph) or more, if response characteristic of A/F
sensor becomes deteriorated
(2 trip detection logic)
A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P1133, P1153) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Author:
Date:
580
DI–346
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Connect the OBDII scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester and read value for
voltage output of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) with the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read voltage of A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester when you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of AFR and AFL terminals of ECM is fixed at 3.3 V and the voltage of AFR and AFL
terminals is fixed at 3.0 V. Therefore, it is impossible to check the A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) output
voltage at the terminals (AFR, AFL/AFR, AFL) of ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle
valve open and close.
Not remains at 3.30 V (*0.660 V)
Not remains at 3.8
3 8 V (*0.76
(*0 76 V) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (*0.56 V) or less
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) is
below 2.8 V (* 0.56 V), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) is above 3.8
V (* 0.76 V), it is normal.
If output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) remains at 3.30 V (* 0.660 V) even after performing
all the above conditions, A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) circuit may be open.
If output voltage of A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) remains at 3.8 V (* 0.76V) or more, or 2.8 V (*0.56
V) or less even after performing all the above conditions, A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1) circuit may
be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
Author:
Date:
581
DI–347
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
4
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (See page SF–68).
NG
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
5
Check air induction system (See page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See page EC–11).
NG
Replace EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel pressure (See page SF–21).
NG
Check and repair fuel pump, fuel pipe line and
filter (See page SF–1).
OK
Author:
Date:
582
DI–348
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check injector injection (See page SF–25).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace A/F sensors (bank1, 2 sensor1).
9
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–197).
Go
10
Are there DTC P1133 and/or P1153 being output again ?
YES
Check and replace ECM
(See page IN–31).
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past ?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
YES
DTC P1133 and /or P1153 is caused by running out of fuel.
Author:
Date:
583
DI–349
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI1K8–04
DTC
P1135
A/F Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1) (Only for California Spec.)
DTC
P1155
A/F Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 2 Sensor 1) (Only for California Spec.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–249.
DTC No.
P1135
P1155
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When heater operates, heater current exceeds 8 A
(2 trip detection logic)
Heater current of 0.25 A or less when heater operates
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or in heater circuit of A/F sensors
(bank 1, 2 sensor 1)
A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) heater
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 (Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop Fuel Control (Only for California Spec.))
on page DI–249.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check voltage between terminal HAFR, HAFL of ECM connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals HAFR, HAFL of the ECM
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
HAFL (+)
HAFR (+)
A02509
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Author:
Date:
584
DI–350
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check resistance of A/F sensor heaters (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) (See page SF–68).
NG
Replace A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1).
OK
Check and repair harness or connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and A/F sensors
(bank 1, 2 sensor 1), and A/F sensors (bank 1, 2 sensor 1) and ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
585
DI–351
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI084–06
DTC
P1300
Igniter Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A DIS (Direct Ignition System) has been adopted. The DIS improves the ignition timing accuracy, reduces
high–voltage loss, and enhances the overall reliability of the ignition system by eliminating the distributor.
The DIS is a 2–cylinder simultaneous ignition system which ignites 2 cylinders simultaneously with one ignition coil. In the 2–cylinder simultaneous ignition system, each of the 2 spark plugs is connected to the end
of the secondary winding. High voltage generated in the secondary winding is applied directly to the spark
plugs. The sparks of the 2 spark plugs pass simultaneously from the center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGT) for each cylinder. Based on IGT
signals, the igniter controls the primary ignition signals (IGC) for all ignition coils. At the same time, the igniter
also sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) as a fail–safe measure to the ECM.
Ignition Coil
Spark Plug
From Battery
Camshaft
Position
Sensor
G
IGT1
IGC1
No.2 Cylinder
No.1 Cylinder
IGT2
Crankshaft
Position
Sensor
NE
IGC2
No.4 Cylinder
ECM
No.3 Cylinder
IGT3
IGC3
No.6 Cylinder
Various
Sensor
IGF
No.5 Cylinder
TAC
GND
To Tachometer
S00251
DTC No.
P1300
DTC Detecting Condition
Condition (a) is repeated 3 times consecutively during 6
consecutively IGT signals while engine is running
(a) IGF signal is not input to ECM for 2 or more ignitions
Trouble Area
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from igniter to ECM
Igniter
ECM
Author:
Date:
586
DI–352
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Ignition
Switch
W–R
5 1K
5 1B
3
B–R 1K
7
6
8
1C B–R
A
1
B–R
2
Y
ECM
B–R
A
A A A
5V
9
10
GR
7
1
BR–Y
No.2 1 B–R
2L
AM2
1
12 B–R
II3
Ignition Coil
1 B–R
Spark Plug
Instrument
2 G
Panel J/B
No.1
W–R
4
J18
Junction
Connector
Instrument
Panel J/B
Engine Room J/B
2
L
6
2
LG–B
No.3
5
2A
B
1 F6 Fusible
Link
Block
F4
1
W–R
4
BR
ED
11 IGT1
E11
12 IGT2
E11
13
E11
IGT3
25 IGF
E11
3
Igniter
B–G FL
MAIN
Battery
S05723
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check spark plug and spark of misfiring cylinder (See page DI–276).
NG
Go to step 4.
OK
Author:
Date:
587
DI–353
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector in IGF signal circuit between
ECM and igniter (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Disconnect igniter connector and check voltage between terminal IGF of ECM
connector and body ground.
ON
IGF (+)
A02033
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the igniter connector.
(b) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal IGF of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
OK
Replace igniter.
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
4
Check for open and short in harness and connector in IGT 1 ∼ 3 signal circuits
between ECM and igniter (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
588
DI–354
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminals IGT 1 ∼ 3 of ECM connector and body ground.
5
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals IGT 1 ∼ 3 of the ECM connector and body ground when engine is cranked.
OK:
Voltage: More than 0.1 V and less than 4.5 V
START
(+) (+) (+)
IGT3 IGT2 IGT1
A02034
IGT1 ∼ IGT3 and IGF Signal Waveform
VOLT
5
0
5
IGT1
0
5
0
IGT2
5
0
IGF
Reference INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
During idling, check waveform between terminals IGT 1 ∼ 3,
IGF and E1 of ECM.
HINT:
The correct waveforms are as shown.
IGT3
20 msec./Division (Idling)
P20870
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
6
Disconnect igniter connector and check voltage between terminals IGT 1 ∼ 3 of
ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the igniter connector.
(b) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals IGT 1 ∼ 3 of the ECM connector and body ground when engine is cranked.
OK:
Voltage: More than 0.1 V and less than 4.5 V
START
(+)
(+) (+)
IGT 3 IGT2 IGT1
A02034
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
Author:
Date:
589
DI–355
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminal 9 of igniter connector and body ground.
ON
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the igniter connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 9 of igniter connector and
body ground when ignition switch is turned to ”ON” and
”START” position.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
START
9 (+)
BE6653
P24329
A00124
NG
Check and repair igniter power source circuit
(See page IG–1).
OK
8
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ignition switch and
ignition coil, and ignition coil and igniter (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
9
Check ignition coil (See page IG–1).
NG
Replace ignition coil.
OK
Author:
Date:
590
DI–356
DIAGNOSTICS
10
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) (See page SF–53).
NG
Replace EFI main relay (Marking: EFI).
OK
Replace igniter.
Author:
Date:
591
DI–357
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI085–06
DTC
P1335
Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit
Malfunction (during engine running)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–287.
DTC No.
P1335
DTC Detecting Condition
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine
speed 1,000 rpm or more
Trouble Area
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Starter
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–287.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Refer to DTC P0335 (Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–287.
Author:
Date:
592
DI–358
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI086–06
DTC
P1410
EGR Valve Position Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The EGR valve position sensor is mounted on the EGR valve
and detects the lift amount of EGR valve. The lift amount of
EGR valve which is detected by the EGR valve position sensor
provides feedback to the ECM to control the lift amount of EGR
valve in response to engine operating conditions.
Output Voltage
5V
0V
Close ← Valve Opening → Open
S06113
DTC No.
P1410
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in EGR valve position sensor circuit
EGR valve position sensor
ECM
Open or short in EGR valve position sensor circuit
(2 trip detection logic)
WIRING DIAGRAM
EGR Valve Position Sensor
ECM
5V
1
Y
3
W–G
2
BR
2
E10
VC
22
E11 EGLS
18
E2
E10
S05464
Author:
Date:
593
DI–359
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs ”P0110” (Intake Air Temp. Circuit Malfunction), ”P0115” (Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction), ”P0120” (Throttle/Pedal Position/Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction), ”P1410” (EGR Valve Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction) are output simultaneously, E2 (Sensor Ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check voltage between terminal VC of wire harness side connector and body
ground.
ON
1 (+)
BE6653
S05694
A00379
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from EGR valve.
(b) Disconnect the EGR valve position sensor connector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of wire harness side connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
NG
Go to step 4.
OK
2
Check EGR valve position sensor.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the EGR valve position sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 (VC) and 2 (E2) of
EGR valve position sensor.
OK:
Resistance: 1.5 ∼ 4.3 kΩ
1
2
S05742
NG
Replace EGR valve position sensor.
OK
Author:
Date:
594
DI–360
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminals EGLS and E2 of ECM connectors.
ON
EGLS (+)
E2 (–)
A02036
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the vacuum hose from EGR valve.
(b) Connect the hand–held vacuum pump to EGR valve.
(c) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals EGLS and E2 of the ECM
connectors.
OK:
Condition
NG
V lt
Voltage
EGR valve
Vacuum
Fully closed
0 kPa
(0 mmHg, 0 in.Hg)
0.4 ∼ 1.6 V
Fully open
17.3 kPa
(130 mmHg, 5.12 in.Hg)
3.2 ∼ 5.1 V
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and EGR valve
position sensor (EGLS or E2 line).
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
595
DI–361
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
ON
VC (+)
E2 (–)
A02022
NG
Check
IN–31).
and
replace
ECM
(See
page
OK
Check for open and short in harness and
connector between ECM and EGR valve
position sensor (VC line).
Author:
Date:
596
DI–362
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI087–06
DTC
P1411
EGR Valve Position Sensor Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P1410 (EGR Valve Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction) on page DI–358.
DTC No.
P1411
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 500 msec. or more:
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Engine Coolant Temp. < 5°C (41°F)
(b) EGLS 1.65 V or EGLS < 0.35 V
EGR valve position sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P1411) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
Replace EGR valve position sensor.
Author:
Date:
597
DI–363
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI088–06
DTC
P1520
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
(Only for A/T)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This signal is used to detect when the brakes have been applied. The STP signal voltage is the same as
the voltage supplied to the stop lights.
The STP signal is used mainly to control the fuel cut–off engine speed (The fuel cut–off engine speed is reduced slightly when the vehicle is braking.).
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P1520
Stop light switch does not turn off when repeating the driving at
30 km or more 10 times or more after depressing brake
(2 trip detection logic)
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Junction
Instrument Panel J/B
Connector
Stop Light Switch Instrument Panel J/B
7
A
5
B–R 4
C G–W 15
STOP
G–W 4
W
STP
G–W
1R
1R
1B
1C
J27
E7
J28
1
2
ALT
F9
1
Fusible
Link
Block
1S
G–W
2
1
E1
7
F4
B–G
FL
MAIN
2
Light
Failure
Sensor
To Stop Light
Battery
A07449
Author:
Date:
598
DI–364
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check operation of stop light.
CHECK:
Check if the stop lights go on and off normally when the brake pedal is operated and released.
NG
Check and repair stop light circuit.
OK
2
Check STP signal.
ON
Brake Pedal
Depressed
Brake Pedal
Released
ON
STP (+)
When using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the STP signal on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Brake pedal is depressed: STP ...... ON
Brake pedal is released: STP ...... OFF
When not using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check voltage between terminal STP of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
A02037
OK
Brake pedal
Voltage
Depressed
7.5 ∼ 14 V
Released
Below 1.5 V
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–197).
NG
Author:
Date:
599
DI–365
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check harness and connector between ECM and stop light switch
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
600
DI–366
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI089–06
DTC
P1600
ECM BATT Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied to terminal BATT of the ECM even when the ignition switch is OFF for
use by the DTC memory and air–fuel ratio adaptive control value memory, etc.
DTC No.
P1600
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open in back up power source circuit
ECM
Open in back up power source circuit
HINT:
If DTC P1600 appear, the ECM does not store another DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Fusible
Link
Block
B–G
1
F4
Engine Room J/B No.2
1
F6
1
B
2A
EFI
1
8
2J
B–Y
E7
BATT
FL
MAIN
Battery
S05470
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because free frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
601
DI–367
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminal BATT of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal BATT of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
LOCK
BATT (+)
A02038
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
2
Check EFI fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room J/B.
CHECK:
Check continuity of EFI fuse.
OK:
Continuity
Engine Room J/B
NG
EFI Fuse
S04162
Check for short in all harness and components
connected to EFI fuse.
OK
Check and repair harness or connector between battery and EFI fuse, and EFI fuse and
ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
602
DI–368
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI08A–06
DTC
P1780
Park/Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch go on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it goes on
terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the terminal NSW voltage
becomes 0V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the park/neutral position switch goes off,
so the voltage of ECM. Terminal NSW becomes battery voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power
source. If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air–fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
2 or more switches are ON simultaneously for ”N”, ”2”, ”L” and
”R” positions
(2 trip detection logic)
P1780
When driving under conditions (a) and (b) for 30 sec. or more
the park/neutral position switch is ON (N position):
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 70 km/h (44 mph) or more
(b) Engine speed: 1,500 NE and 2,500 rpm
Trouble Area
Short
Sh t in
i park/neutral
k/
t l position
iti switch
it h circuit
i it
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P1780, use the TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the PNP switch signal from
”CURRENT DATA”.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1780 on page DI–479.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to DTC P1780 (Park/Neutral Position Switch Malfunction) on page DI–479.
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected, when troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio lean or rich, etc.
at the time of the malfunction.
Author:
Date:
603
DI–369
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI4DU–01
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
When the ignition switch is turned on, battery positive voltage is applied to terminal IGSW of the ECM and
the EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) control circuit in the ECM sends a signal to terminal MREL of the ECM
switching on the EFI main relay.
This signal causes current to flow to the coil, closing the contacts of the EFI, main relay and supplying power
to terminals +B of the ECM.
If the ignition switch is turned off, the ECM continues to switch on the EFI main relay for a maximum of 2
seconds for the initial setting of the IAC valve.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
6
B–Y
7 W–R
5
1K
5
1B
2
E7
B–R
Junction
Connector
B
B
J27
J28
B–Y
IGSW
16
+B
E7
W–R
B+
B–W
4
2L
2 2J 7 2K
3
AM2
C
C
J35
J35
B–W
8
MREL
E7
Junction
Connector
1
EFI
Relay
Engine Room
J/B
5
2
EFI
Fusible
Link
FL
Block
1
MAIN B–G 1
F4
F6
Battery
1
2A
B
4
2F
W–B
Ignition Switch
B–R
Instrument Panel J/B
3
7
IGN
1K
1W
EB
J22
Junction
Connector
BR
BR
A
A
17
E10 E1
EC
A07450
Author:
Date:
604
DI–370
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals +B and E1 or ECM connectors.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals +B and E1 of the ECM
connectors.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
+B (+)
E1 (–)
A02382
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–221).
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between terminals E1 of ECM and
body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check voltage between terminal IGSW of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal IGSW of ECM connectors
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
IGSW (+)
A02951
OK
Go to step 6.
NG
Author:
Date:
605
DI–371
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check EFI fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove IGN fuse from instrument panel J/B.
CHECK:
Check continuity of IGN fuse.
OK:
Continuity
IGN Fuse
NG
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to IGN fuse
(See attached wiring diagram).
Instrument Panel J/B
S04164
OK
5
Check ignition switch (See page BE–13).
NG
Replace ignition switch.
OK
Check and repair harness and connector between battery and ignition switch, and ignition switch and ECM.
Author:
Date:
606
DI–372
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminal MREL of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal MREL of the ECM
connectors and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
MREL (+)
A02952
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page DI–197).
OK
7
Check EFI No.1 fuse of engine room J/B.
NG
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to EFI No.1 fuse
(See attached wiring diagram).
OK
8
Check EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) (See page SF–53).
NG
Replace EFI main relay (Marking: EFI).
OK
Author:
Date:
607
DI–373
DIAGNOSTICS
9
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between terminal MREL of
ECM and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or harness or connector.
OK
Check and repair harness or connector between EFI No.1 fuse and battery
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
608
DI–374
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI4DV–01
Fuel Pump Control Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
In the diagram below, when the engine is cranked, current flows from terminal ST of the ignition switch to
the starter relay coil and also current flows to terminal STA of ECM (STA signal).
When the STA signal and NE signal are input to the ECM, Tr is turned ON, current flows to coil of the circuit
opening relay, the relay switches on, power is supplied to the fuel pump and the fuel pump operates.
While the NE signal is generated (engine running), the ECM keeps Tr ON (circuit opening relay ON) and the
fuel pump also keeps operating.
EFI Main Relay
Circuit Opening Relay
EFI
Fuel Pump
ECM
FC
Tr
MREL
IG Switch
IGN
IGSW
AM2
STARTER
Park/ Neutral Position Switch
MAIN
(STA Signal) STA
(NE Signal)
Battery
NE
Starter Relay
Starter
A07151
Author:
Date:
609
B–W
AM2
5
3
1
2
B
10
B–R
2C
4
W–B
2F
5
11 2J
2
B
5
G–R
EB1
G–R
3
FC
E7
2
E01
–
J11
Junction
Connector
A
Pump
1
S2
5
W–B
B–R
1K
A
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
1W
A
3
W–B
4
W–B
7
ID1
L–B
AM2
7
Fuel
*1GR
(M/T)*B–O
6
7
II2
(A/T) GR
R
W–R
IG2
Park/
Nutral
Position
Switch
10
B–R
IGN
5
2
ST2
(A/T)
Switch
II2
EB1
B–R
11
B–W
STARTER
Start
(A/T)
B–W
(M/T) B–W
1
10
7 1K1
L–B
B
Clutch
8
Battery
B
3 1J
4 1K
B
J7
C J8
J26
Junction
Connector
B
5 1K
1
B–R
Junction
Connector
*1GR
(A/T) *B–O
W–B
Date:
Instrument Panel J/B
B–G
Author:
FL
MAIN
B–W
5 1B
1
L–B
ST Relay
*1GR
*B–O
1 F6 Fusible
Link
1 F4 Block
1
1
5
B–R
2D
9
W–B
2K
3
1
3
1
DIAGNOSTICS
5
MAIN
4 2L
MREL
CIR OPN Relay
EFI Relay
3
2B
8
E7
B–W
Engine Room R/B
7 2K
EFI
1
2A
B+
Junction
Connector
C
J35
J35
WIRING DIAGRAM
*: TMMK made
*1: TMC made
ECM
Starter J40
EB
Junction
Connector
BL
IG
DI–375
A07451
610
DI–376
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
1
Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester and check operation of fuel pump.
ON
BE6653
P20186
A00244
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(c) Use ACTIVE TEST mode to operate the fuel pump.
CHECK:
Check that pulsation damper screw rises up when fuel pump is
on by TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
The pulsation damper screw rises up.
OK
Check for starter signal circuit
( See page DI–384).
NG
2
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–369).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check circuit opening relay (See page SF–54).
NG
Replace circuit opening relay.
OK
Author:
Date:
611
DI–377
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal FC of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
Voltage 9 – 14 V
ON
FC (+)
A02064
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and circuit
opening relay, circuit opening relay and ECM.
OK
5
Check fuel pump (See page SF–6).
NG
Repair or replace fuel pump.
OK
6
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay
and fuel pump, and fuel pump and body ground
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
612
DI–378
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
1
Check operation of fuel pump.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
(a) Connect between terminal FC of the ECM connector and
body ground.
(b) Check that pulsation damper screw rises up when connect between terminal FC of the ECM and body ground.
OK:
The pulsation damper screw rises up.
ON
FC
OK
Check for starter signal circuit
( See page DI–384).
A02042
NG
2
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–369).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
3
Check circuit opening relay (See page SF–54).
NG
Replace circuit opening relay.
OK
Author:
Date:
613
DI–379
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal FC of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
Voltage 9 – 14 V
ON
FC (+)
A02064
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and circuit
opening relay, circuit opening relay and ECM.
OK
5
Check fuel pump (See page SF–6).
NG
Repair or replace fuel pump.
OK
6
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay and fuel
pump, and fuel pump and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
614
DI–380
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI08E–06
IACV Control VSV Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit opens and closes the IACV (Intake Air Control Valve) in response to the engine load in order to
increase the intake efficiency (ACIS: Acoustic Control Induction System).
When the engine speed is 3,700 rpm or less and the throttle valve opening angle is 60° or more, the ECM
turns the VSV ON and closes the IACV. At all other times, the VSV is OFF, so the IACV is open.
IACV closed (VSV: ON)
1
3
5
Throttle valve
opening angle
IACV
Throttle Valve
2
4
30°
6
3,700 rpm
Engine speed
FI7011 FI6570
A00306
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
B+
Engine Room J/B
W–B
4
2F
2
2J
7
2K
1
EFI
3
5
B–W
1
2A
8
E7
MREL
From Battery
EFI Relay
B–Y
EB
2
Junction Connector
C
C
B–W
J36
J35
B
J27
B
J28
Junction
Connector
B–Y
9
II3
B–Y A
VSV for ACIS
A B–Y
R–Y
2
1
17
E11
J20
Junction
Connector
ACIS
E01
A07452
Author:
Date:
615
DI–381
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester
1
Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester and check operation of VSV for ACIS.
ON
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
Air
Air
E
E
F
F
Air Filter
BE6653
FI7073 FI7074
Air Filter
A00307
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument panel.
(b) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(d) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
CHECK:
Check operation of VSV when VSV is operated by the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
VSV is ON:
Air from pipe E is flowing out through pipe F.
VSV is OFF:
Air from pipe E is flowing out through the air filter.
OK
Check for vacuum tank (See page SF–51).
NG
2
Check VSV for ACIS (See page SF–60).
NG
Replace VSV for ACIS.
OK
Author:
Date:
616
DI–382
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay
(Marking: EFI) and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
1
Check VSV for ACIS (See page SF–60).
NG
Replace VSV for ACIS.
OK
2
Check voltage between terminal ACIS of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal ACIS of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
ACIS (+)
A02041
NG
Check for open and short in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI)
and ECM (See page IN–31).
OK
Author:
Date:
617
DI–383
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
Check for vacuum tank (See page SF–60).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
618
DI–384
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
DI08B–06
Starter Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, the intake air flow is slow, so fuel vaporization is poor. A rich mixture is therefore
necessary in order to achieve good startability. While the engine is being cranked, the battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM. The starter signal is mainly used to increase the fuel injection
volume for the starting injection control and after–start injection control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
*GR
*B–O(M/T)
B–W(A/T)
B
J7
11
2J 1
MAIN
1
2
ECM
5
2D
9
2K
B
B
1
S2
Starter
B–W(A/T)
J11
A
Junction
Connector A
J16
Junction
Connector
B–W
W–B
STARTER
3 1J
Instrument
Panel J/B
W–B
Sarter Relay
5 B–W(A/T)
11 II2
B
B–R
W–B
1
*1B–O
*GR
*1B–O
*GR
B J7
Junction
Park/Neutral
Connector
Position Switch
2
B–W(M/T)
Clutch Start Switch
6
C
J8
10
II2
GR
3
2B
B
From Battery
Engine Room J/B
3
5
*1GR
*B–O
7 STA
E7
4 1K
IG
E1
From Ignition Switch
*: TMMK made
*1: TMC made
A07453
Author:
Date:
619
DI–385
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
This diagnostic chart is based on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the engine is not
cranked, proceed to the problem symptoms table on page DI–221.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
1
Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester, and check STA signal.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read STA signal on the TOYOTA hand–held tester while starter operates.
OK:
Ignition switch position
ON
START
STA signal
OFF
ON
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptom table (See page DI–221).
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and starter relay
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
620
DI–386
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE (1MZ–FE)
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
1
Check voltage between terminal STA of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal STA of the ECM connector
and body ground during engine cranking.
OK:
Voltage: 6 V or more
ON
STA (+)
A07152
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptom table (See page DI–221).
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and starter relay
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
621
DI–387
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI02U–02
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manual, with the
page number indicated in the bottom portion. See the indicated
pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–388
2
Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
If the display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE” when you have connected the
scan tool / TOYOTA hand–held tester, inspect DLC3 P. DI–389
3 Check DTC and Freeze Frame Data (Precheck)
Record or Print DTC and Freeze Frame Data P. DI–389
4
Clear DTC and Freeze Frame Data P. DI–389
5 Visual Inspection
6 Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis P. DI–389
Symptom does not occur
8
7 Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
Symptom occurs
9
DTC Check
P. DI–389
10
DTC Chart
P. DI–401
OK Code 11
OK
Mechanical System Test
P. DI–389
NG 12
OK
Manual Shifting Test
P. DI–389
NG
NG
Problem Symptoms Table– P. DI–405
13
Chapter 1
(Electronic)
P. DI–405
NG
14
Preliminary Check NG
P. DI–389
Circuit
Inspection
Chapter 2
(On–Vehicle)
P. DI–405
OK
OK
Chapter 3
(Off–Vehicle)
P. DI–405
NG
NG
O/D Cancel Signal Check
O/D Main Switch & O/D OFF Indicator Light Circuit Check
15 Parts Inspection
P. DI–428 to DI–431
Identification of Problem
16
Repair
17
Confirmation Test
Author:
End
Date:
622
DI–388
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI02V–02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Transaxle Control
System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
:
Registration No.
Customer’s Name
Registration Year
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem
Occurred
How Often Problem Occurs ?
/
km
mile
Odometer Reading
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
Vehicle does not move ( Any position
No up–shift
( 1st → 2nd
No down–shift
( O/D → 3rd
times a day)
Particular position )
2nd → 3rd
3rd → 2nd
3rd → O/D )
2nd → 1st )
Lock–up malfunction
Symptoms
Shift point too high or too low
Harsh engagement ( N → D
Lock–up
Any drive position )
Slip or shudder
No kick–down
Others
Check Item
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Normal
Remains ON
1st Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (Code
)
DTC Check
Author:
Date:
623
DI–389
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI02W–02
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
FI0534
TOYOTA hand–held tester
DLC3
S05335
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure
is that you connect an OBD II scan tool complying
with SAE J1987 or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
vehicle, and read off various data output from the
vehicle’s ECM.
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s on–
board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the computer itself or
in drive system components which affect vehicle
emissions. In addition to the MIL lighting up when
a malfunction is detected, the applicable DTCs prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the ECM
memory (See page DI–16).
If the malfunction only occurs in 3 trips, the MIL goes
off but the DTCs remain recorded in the ECM
memory.
To check the DTCs, connect an OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 on the vehicle.
The OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester
also enables you to erase the DTCs and check
freeze frame data and various forms of engine data
(For instruction book).
DTCs include SAE controlled codes and Manufacturer controlled codes.
SAE controlled codes must be set as the codes prescribed by the SAE, while Manufacturer controlled
codes can be set freely by the manufacturer within
the prescribed limits.
(See DTC chart on page DI–401)
Author:
Date:
624
DI–390
DIAGNOSTICS
–
(b)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode
during normal vehicle use, and also has a check
mode for technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms and perform troubleshooting. Most DTCs use
2 trip detection logic(*) to prevent erroneous detection. By switching the ECM to check mode when
troubleshooting, the technician can cause the MIL
to light up and for a malfunction that is only detected
once or momentarily.
(TOYOTA hand–held tester) (See page DI–401)
*2 trip detection logic:
When a logic malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is temporarily stored in the ECM memory.
If the same malfunction is detected again during the
2nd test drive, this 2nd detection causes the MIL to
light up.
Inspect the DLC3.
The vehicle’s ECM uses V.P.W. (Variable Pulse Width) for
communication to comply with SAE J1850. The terminal
arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and
matches the V.P.W. format.
DLC3
N09214
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 (Bus Line) – 5 (Signal ground)
During communication
4 (Chassis Ground) – Body
Always
1 Ω or less
5 (Signal Ground) – Body
Always
1 Ω or less
16 (B+) – Body
Always
9 – 14 V
Pulse generation
HINT:
If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE”
when you have connected the cable of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON
and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle
side or tool side.
If communication is normal when the tool is connected to
another vehicle, inspect DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in the
tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in the
tool’s instruction manual.
Author:
Date:
625
DI–391
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
FI0534
TOYOTA hand–held tester
DLC3
S05335
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (NORMAL MODE)
Check the MIL.
(1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned
ON and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter
(See page BE–47).
(2) When the engine is started, the MIL should go off.
If the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system has
detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
(b) Check the DTC.
NOTICE:
(TOYOTA hand–held tester only): When the diagnostic system is switched from normal mode to check mode, it erases
all DTCs and freeze frame data recorded in normal mode.
So before switching modes, always check the DTCs and
freeze frame data, and note them down.
(1) Prepare an OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
(2) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester to DLC3 at the lower portion of the instrument panel.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester switch ON.
(4) Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to check the DTCs and freeze frame data and
note them down (For operating instructions, see the
OBD II scan tool’s instruction book).
(5) See page DI–401 to confirm the details of the DTCs.
NOTICE:
When simulating symptoms with an OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) to check the DTCs, use
normal mode. For codes on the DTCs chart subject to ”2
trip detection logic”, turn the ignition switch off after the
symptoms have been simulated the 1st time. Then repeat
the simulation process again. When the program has
DTCs, the DTCs are recorded in the ECM.
Author:
Date:
626
DI–392
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
3.
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (CHECK MODE)
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only: Compared to the Normal
mode, the Check mode has high sensing ability to detect malfunctions. Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are
detected in Normal mode can also be detected in Check mode.
(a) Check the DTC.
(1) Check the initial conditions.
Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
Throttle valve fully closed
Transaxle in P position
Air conditioning switched off
(2) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(3) Prepare a TOYOTA hand–held tester.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
(4)
(5)
DLC3
S05335
(6)
0.13 sec.
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 at
the lower side of the instrument panel.
Turn the ignition switch ON and switch the TOYOTA
hand–held tester ON.
(7)
0.13 sec.
ON
(8)
OFF
BR3904
Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from Normal
mode to Check mode (Check that the MIL flashes).
Start the engine (MIL goes out after the engine
starts).
Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by the customer.
NOTICE:
Leave the ignition switch ON until you have checked the
DTCs, etc.
(9) After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
TOYOTA hand–held tester diagnosis selector to
check the DTCs and freeze frame data, etc.
HINT:
Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF, as turning it off the
diagnosis system switches from Check mode to Normal mode,
so all DTCs, etc. are erased.
(10) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
Author:
Date:
627
DI–393
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Clearance the DTC.
The following actions will erase the DTC and freeze frame
data. Operating an OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase the codes.
(See the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book for operating
instructions.)
4.
ROAD TEST
NOTICE:
Perform the test at normal operating ATF temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
(a) D position test
Shift into the D position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and and check the following points:
(1) Check up–shift operation.
1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D up–shifts take place, at the shift point shown in the automatic shift
schedule (See page SS–54).
HINT:
O/D Gear Up–shift Prohibition Control (1. Coolant temp. is 50 °C (122 °C) or less. 2. If there is a 10
km/h (6 mph) difference between the set cruise control speed and vehicle speed.)
O/D Gear Lock–up Prohibition Control (1. Brake pedal is depressed. 2. Coolant temp. is 50 °C
(122 °C) or less.)
(2) Check for shift shock and slip.
Check for shock and slip at the 1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D up–shifts.
(3) Check for abnormal noises and vibration.
Run at the D position lock–up or O/D gear and check for abnormal noises and vibration.
HINT:
The check for the cause of abnormal noises and vibration must be done very thoroughly as it could also be
due to loss of balance in the differential or torque converter clutch, etc.
(4) Check kick–down operation.
While running in the D position, 2nd, 3rd and O/D gears, check to see that the possible kick–down
vehicle speed limits for 2 → 1, 3 → 2 and O/D → 3 kick–downs conform to those indicated on
the automatic shift schedule (See page SS–54).
(5) Check abnormal shock and slip at kick–down.
(6) Check the lock–up mechanism.
Drive in D position, O/D gear, at a steady speed (lock–up ON) of about 75 km/h (47 mph).
Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check that the engine speed does not change
abruptly.
If there is a big jump in engine speed, there is no lock–up.
(b) 2 position test
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points:
(1) Check up–shift operation.
Check to see that the 1 → 2 up–shift takes place and that the shift point conforms to the automatic
shift schedule (See page SS–54).
HINT:
There is no O/D up–shift and lock–up in the 2 position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the 2 position and 2nd gear, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine
braking effect.
Author:
Date:
628
DI–394
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
(3)
Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration, and for shock at up–shift and
down–shift.
(c) L position test
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points:
(1) Check no up–shift.
While running in the L position, check that there is no up–shift to 2nd gear.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the L position, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration.
(d) R position test
Shift into the R position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check for slipping.
CAUTION:
Before conducting this test ensure that the test area is free from people and obstruction.
(e) P position test
Stop the vehicle on a grade (more than 5°) and after shifting into the P position, release the parking
brake. Then, check to see that the parking lock pawl holds the vehicle in place.
Q00519
5.
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Check the fluid level.
HINT:
Drive the vehicle so that the engine and transaxle are at
normal operating temperature.
Fluid temp.: 70 – 80 °C (158 – 176 °F)
Only use the COOL range on the dipstick as a rough reference when the fluid is replaced or the engine does not
run.
(1)
OK if hot
Add if hot
AT3417
Park the vehicle on a level surface and set the parking brake.
(2) With the engine idling and the brake pedal depressed, shift the shift lever into all positions from P
to L position and return to P position.
(3) Pull out the dipstick and wipe it clean.
(4) Push it back fully into the pipe.
(5) Pull it out and check that the fluid level is in the HOT
range.
If the level is not within the range, add new fluid.
Fluid type: ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
NOTICE:
Do not overfill.
(b) Check the fluid condition.
If the level is not within the hot range.
Author:
Date:
629
DI–395
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Replace the ATF.
(1) Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid.
(2) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
Q00061
(3)
With the engine OFF add new fluid through the oil
filler pipe.
Fluid type: ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
Capacity: 2.5 liters (2.6 US qts, 2.1 Imp. qts)
(4) Start the engine and shift the shift lever into all positions from P to L position and then shift into P position.
AT8562
(5)
OK if hot
(6)
Add if hot
AT3417
With the engine idling, check the fluid level. Add
fluid up to the COOL level on the dipstick.
Check the fluid level is at the normal operating temperature, 70 – 80 °C (158 – 176 °F), and add as
necessary.
NOTICE:
Do not overfill.
(d) Check the fluid leaks.
Check for leaks in the transaxle.
If there are leaks, it is necessary to repair or replace O–rings,
gasket, oil seals, plugs or other parts.
(e)
Inspect and adjust the throttle cable.
(1) Check that the accelerator pedal is fully released.
(2) Check that the inner cable is not slack.
(3) Measure the distance between the outer cable end
and stopper on the cable.
Standard distance: 0 – 1 mm (0 – 0.04 in.)
If the distance is not standard, adjust the cable by the adjusting
nuts.
0 ∼ 1 mm (0 ∼ 0.04 in.)
AT4252
Author:
Date:
630
DI–396
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
(f)
Q00199
Inspect and adjust the shift lever position.
When shifting the shift lever from the N position to other
positions, check that the lever can be shifted smoothly
and accurately to each position and that the position indicator is aligned with the correct position.
If the indicator is not aligned with the correct position, carry out
the following adjustment procedures.
(1) Loosen the nut on the shift lever.
(2) Push the control shaft fully rearward.
(3)
P
R
N
Q01561
Neutral Basic line
Groove
AT4478
Return the control shaft lever 2 notches to N position.
(4) Set the shift lever to N position.
(5) While holding the shift lever lightly toward the R
position side, tighten the shift lever nut.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(6) Start the engine and make sure that the vehicle
moves forward when shifting the lever from the N to
D position and reverses when shifting it to the R
position.
(g) Inspect and adjust the park/neutral position.
Check that the engine can be started with the shift lever
only in the N or P position, but not in other positions.
If it is not as stated above, carry out the following adjustment
procedures.
(1) Loosen the park/neutral position switch bolt and set
the shift lever to the N position.
(2) Align the groove and neutral basic line.
(3) Hold the switch in position and tighten the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in·lbf)
For continuity inspection of the park/neutral position
switch, see page DI–424.
(h) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed : 750 ± 50 rpm
(In N position and air conditioner OFF)
Author:
Date:
631
DI–397
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
6.
(a)
MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
Measure the stall speed.
The object of this test is to check the overall performance of the transaxle and engine by measuring
the stall speeds in the D and R positions.
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
Do not continuously run this test for longer than 5 seconds.
To ensure safety, conduct this test in a wide, clear level area which provides good traction.
The stall test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
(1) Chock the 4 wheels.
(2) Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(3) Fully apply the parking brake.
(4) Keep your left foot depressing firmly on the brake pedal.
(5) Start the engine.
(6) Shift into the D position. Press all the way down on the accelerator pedal with your right foot.
Quickly read the stall speed at this time.
Stall speed: 2,450 ± 150 rpm
(7) Do the same test in R position.
Stall speed: 2,450 ± 150 rpm
Evaluation:
Problem
Possible cause
(a) Stall speed low in D and R positions
Engine output may be insufficient
Stator one–way clutch is operating properly
HINT: If more than 600 rpm below the specified value, the torque
converter clutch could be faulty.
(b) Stall speed high in D position
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch slipping
No.2 one–way clutch not operating properly
O/D clutch slipping
(c) Stall speed high in R position
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch slipping
1st & reverse brake slipping
O/D clutch slipping
(d) Stall speed high in D and R positions
Line pressure too low
Improper fluid level
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
Author:
Date:
632
DI–398
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
(b)
Measure the time lag.
When the shift lever is shifted while the engine is idling, there will be a certain time lapse or lag before
the shock can be felt. This is used for checking the condition of the O/D direct clutch, forward clutch,
and 1st & reverse brake.
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
Be sure to allow 1 minute interval between tests.
Take 3 measurements and take the average value.
(1) Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(2) Fully apply the parking brake.
(3) Start the engine and check idle speed.
Idle speed : 750 ± 50 rpm (In N position and air conditioner OFF)
(4) Shift the shift lever from N to D position. Using a stop watch, measure the time from when the
lever is shifted until the shock is felt.
Time lag: N → D Less than 1.2 seconds
(5) In the same manner, measure the time lag for N → R.
Time lag: N → R Less than 1.5 seconds
Evaluation (If N → D time or N → R time lag is longer than the specified):
Problem
Possible cause
N → D time lag is longer
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch worn
O/D one–way clutch not operating
N → R time lag is longer
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch worn
1st & reverse brake worn
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
Author:
Date:
633
DI–399
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
7.
HYDRAULIC TEST
Measure the line pressure.
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operation fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
The line pressure test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe
the conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
Be careful to prevent SST’s hose from interfering with the exhaust pipe.
(1) Warm up the ATF.
(2) Remove the test plug on the transaxle case front left side and connect SST.
(See page AX–17 for the location to connect SST)
SST 09992–00095 (09992–00231, 09992–00271)
(3) Fully apply the parking brake and chock the 4 wheels.
(4) Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(5) Start the engine and check idling speed.
(6) Keep your left foot pressing firmly on the brake pedal and shift into D position.
(7) Measure the line pressure when the engine is idling.
(8) Depress the accelerator pedal all the way down. Quickly read the highest line pressure when
engine speed reaches stall speed.
(9) In the same manner, do the test in R position.
Specified line pressure:
Condition
D position
kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
R position
kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
Idling
362 – 422 (3.7 – 4.3, 53 – 61)
618 – 794 (6.3 – 8.1, 90 – 115)
Stall
735 – 862 (7.5 – 8.8, 107 – 125)
1,373 – 1,608 (14.0 – 16.4, 199 – 233)
If the measured pressure is not up to the specified value, recheck the throttle cable adjustment and retest.
Evaluation
Problem
Possible cause
If the measured values at all positions are higher
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
If the measured values at all positions are lower
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
Oil pump defective
O/D direct clutch defective
If pressure is low in the D position only
D position circuit fluid leakage
Forward clutch defective
If pressure is low in the R position only
R position circuit fluid leakage
Direct clutch defective
1st & reverse brake defective
Author:
Date:
634
DI–400
DIAGNOSTICS
Q00200
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
8.
MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
HINT:
By this test, it can be determined whether the trouble is within
the electrical circuit or is a mechanical problem in the transaxle.
(a) Disconnect the solenoid wire.
(b) Inspect the manual driving operation.
Check that the shift and gear positions correspond to the
table below.
While driving, shift through the L, 2 and D positions.
Check that the gear change corresponds to the shift position.
Shift Position
Gear Position
D
O/D
2
3rd
L
1st
R
Reverse
P
Pawl Lock
HINT:
If the L, 2 and D gear positions are difficult to distinguish, do the
above test.
If any abnormality is found in the above test, the problem is in
the transaxle itself.
(c) Connect the solenoid wire.
(d) Clear out the DTC (See page DI–389).
Author:
Date:
635
DI–401
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI02X–02
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a DTC is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table below and proceed to the page given.
* : ...MIL light up
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL *
Memory
P0500
(DI–408)
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
(No.1 Vehicle Speed Sensor)
Open or short in No.1 vehicle speed sensor circuit
No.1 vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0750
(DI–411)
Shift Solenoid A Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1)
Shift solenoid valve No.1 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0753
(DI–413)
Shift Solenoid A Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.1
ECM
P0755
(DI–411)
Shift Solenoid B Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.2)
Shift solenoid valve No.2 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0758
(DI–413)
Shift Solenoid B Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.2)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.2
ECM
P0770
(DI–417)
Shift Solenoid E Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Lock–up clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0773
(DI–419)
Shift Solenoid E Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL
ECM
P1520
(DI–170)
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
Open or short in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
P1780
(DI–424)
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Malfunction
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
Author:
Date:
636
DI–402
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI02Y–02
PARTS LOCATION
O/D Main Switch
O/D OFF Indicator Light
ECM
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Shift Solenoid Valve SL
DLC3
Stop Light Switch
Shift Solenoid Valve No.2
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Shift Solenoid Valve No.1
D00938
Author:
Date:
637
DI–403
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI1IZ–01
TERMINALS OF ECM
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
ECM Terminals
E9
E8
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
E10
E7
6 5 4 3 2 1
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
FI6526
Symbols (Terminals No.)
S1 ↔ E1 (E9–8
(E9 8 ↔ E9
E9–24)
24)
S2 ↔ E1 (E9
(E9–21
21 ↔ E9
E9–24)
24)
SL ↔ E1 (E9–20
(E9 20 ↔ E9–24)
E9 24)
Wiring Color
V ↔ BR
L–B
L
B ↔ BR
P ↔ BR
OD1 ↔ E1 (E7–18 ↔ E9–24)
Y–B ↔ BR
OD2 ↔ E1 (E7–5
(E7 5 ↔ E9–24)
E9 24)
G O ↔ BR
G–O
L ↔ E1 (E7–15
(E7 15 ↔ E9–24)
E9 24)
Y ↔ BR
2 ↔ E1 (E7–16
(E7 16 ↔ E9–24)
E9 24)
*1L
L–W
W ↔ BR
*2O ↔ BR
R ↔ E1 (E7
(E7–17
17 – E9
E9–24)
24)
R B ↔ BR
R–B
NSW ↔ E1 (E7–22
(E7 22 ↔ E9–24)
E9 24)
*1:
*2:
B W ↔ BR
B–W
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
IG ON
9 ∼ 14
1st or 2nd gear
9 ∼ 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
1st or 2nd gear
9 ∼ 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
Vehicle driving under lock–up position
9 ∼ 14
IG ON
9 ∼ 14
O/D main switch ON
9 ∼ 14
O/D main switch OFF
Below 1
9 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever L position
IG ON and Shift lever other than L position
Below 1
9 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever 2 position
IG ON and Shift lever other than 2 position
Below 1
9 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever R position
IG ON and Shift lever other than R position
Below 1
9 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever P or N position
IG ON and Shift lever other than P or N position
Below 1
TMC made
TMMK made
Author:
Date:
638
DI–404
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
ECM Terminals
E9
Symbols (Terminals No.)
S1 ↔ E1 (E9–7
(E9 7 ↔ E9
E9–14)
14)
S2 ↔ E1 (E9–6
(E9 6 ↔ E9
E9–14)
14)
SL ↔ E1 (E9–1
(E9 1 ↔ E9–14)
E9 14)
E8
Wiring Color
V ↔ BR
L–B
L
B ↔ BR
P ↔ BR
OD1 ↔ E1 (E7–20 ↔ E9–14)
Y–B ↔ BR
OD2 ↔ E1 (E7–7
(E7 7 ↔ E9–14)
E9 14)
G O ↔ BR
G–O
L ↔ E1 (E7–19
(E7 19 ↔ E9–14)
E9 14)
Y ↔ BR
2 ↔ E1 (E7–18
(E7 18 ↔ E9–14)
E9 14)
*1L
L–W
W ↔ BR
*2O ↔ BR
R ↔ E1 (E7
(E7–17
17 – E9
E9–14)
14)
R B ↔ BR
R–B
NSW ↔ E1 (E7–22
(E7 22 ↔ E9–14)
E9 14)
B W ↔ BR
B–W
E7
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
IG ON
9 ∼ 14
1st or 2nd gear
9 ∼ 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
1st or 2nd gear
9 ∼ 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
Vehicle driving under lock–up position
9 ∼ 14
IG ON
9 ∼ 14
O/D main switch ON
9 ∼ 14
O/D main switch OFF
Below 1
9 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever L position
IG ON and Shift lever other than L position
Below 1
9 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever 2 position
IG ON and Shift lever other than 2 position
Below 1
9 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever R position
IG ON and Shift lever other than R position
Below 1
9 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever P or N position
IG ON and Shift lever other than P or N position
Below 1
*1: TMC made
*2: TMMK made
Author:
Date:
639
DI–405
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI030–02
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal code is displayed during the DTC check but the trouble still occurs, check the circuits for each
symptom in the order given in the charts on the following pages and proceed to the page given for troubleshooting.
The Matrix Chart is divided into 3 chapters.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Chapter 2: On–vehicle Repair Matrix Chart
Chapter 3: Off–vehicle repair Matrix Chart
If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the flow
chart for each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to continue
the check.
If the trouble still occurs even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits, then
check and replace the ECM.
1.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
No up–shift
(A particular gear, from 1st to 3rd gear, is not up–shifted)
1. ECM
IN–31
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
1. O/D main switch & O/D OFF indicator light circuit
2. O/D cancel signal circuit
3. ECM
DI–431
DI–428
IN–31
No down–shift (O/D → 3rd)
1. ECM
IN–31
No down–shift
(A particular gear, from 3rd to 1st gear, is not down–shifted)
1. ECM
IN–31
No lock–up or No lock–up off
1. Stop light switch circuit
2. ECM
DI–423
IN–31
Shift point too high or too low
1. ECM
IN–31
Up–shift to O/D from 3rd while O/D main switch is OFF
1. O/D main switch & O/D OFF indicator light circuit
2. ECM
DI–431
IN–31
Up–shift to O/D from 3rd while engine is cold
1. ECM
IN–31
Poor acceleration
1. ECM
IN–31
No kick–down
1. ECM
IN–31
Engine stalls when starting off or stopping
1. ECM
IN–31
Author:
Date:
640
DI–406
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Chapter 2: On–Vehicle Repair
(: A140E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM385U)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Vehicle does not move in any forward positions and reverse position
1. Manual valve
2. Throttle valve
3. Primary regulator valve
4. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Vehicle does not move in R position
1. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No up–shift (1st → 2nd)
1. 1–2 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No up–shift (2nd → 3rd)
1. 2–3 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
1. 3–4 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No down–shift (O/D → 3rd)
1. 3–4 shift valve
No down–shift (3rd → 2nd)
1. 2–3 shift valve
No down–shift (2nd → 1st)
1. 1–2 shift valve
No lock–up or No lock–up off
1. Lock–up relay valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1. C1 accumulator
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Harsh engagement (N → R)
1. C2 accumulator
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Harsh engagement (N → L)
1. Low coast modulator valve
Harsh engagement (Lock–up)
1. Lock–up relay valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Harsh engagement (1st → 2nd → 3rd → O/D)
1. Throttle modulator valve
2. Cut back valve
3. Throttle valve
Harsh engagement (2nd → 3rd)
1. C2 accumulator
Harsh engagement (3rd → O/D)
1. B0 accumulator
Harsh engagement (O/D → 3rd)
1. C0 accumulator
2. B0 accumulator
Slip or shudder (Forward and reverse)
1. Throttle valve
2. Oil strainer
3. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No engine braking (1st: L position)
1. Low coast modulator valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No engine braking (2nd: 2 position)
1. 2nd coast modulator valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No kick–down
1. 1–2 shift valve
2. 2–3 shift valve
3. 3–4 shift valve
Author:
Date:
641
DI–407
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Chapter 3: Off–Vehicle Repair
(: A140E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM385U)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Vehicle does not move in any forward positions and reverse position
1. Front and rear planetary gear
2. O/D planetary gear
3. O/D one–way clutch (F0)
4. O/D direct clutch (C0)
5. O/D brake (B0)
6. Forward clutch (C1)
Vehicle does not move in R position
1. Front and rear planetary gear unit
2. Direct clutch (C2)
3. O/D direct clutch (C0)
4. 1st & reverse brake (B3)
No up–shift (1st → 2nd)
1. No. 1 one–way clutch (F1)
2. 2nd brake (B2)
No up–shift (2nd → 3rd)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
1. O/D brake (B0)
No lock–up or No lock–up off
1. Torque converter clutch
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1. Forward clutch (C1)
2. O/D one–way clutch (F0)
3. No. 2 one–way clutch (F2)
Harsh engagement (N → R)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
2. 1st & reverse brake (B3)
Harsh engagement (Lock–up)
1. Torque converter clutch
AX–26
Slip or shudder (Forward position: After warm–up)
1. Torque converter clutch
2. O/D direct clutch (C0)
3. Forward clutch (C1)
4. O/D one–way clutch (F0)
AX–26
Slip or shudder (R position)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
2. 1st & reverse brake (B3)
3. O/D direct clutch (C0)
Slip or shudder (1st)
1. No. 2 one–way clutch (F2)
Slip or shudder (2nd)
1. No. 1 one–way clutch (F1)
2. 2nd brake (B2)
Slip or shudder (3rd)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
Slip or shudder (O/D)
1. O/D brake (B0)
No engine braking (1st ∼ 3rd: D position)
1. 2nd brake (B2)
No engine braking (1st: L position)
1. 1st & reverse brake (B3)
No engine braking (2nd: 2 position)
1. 2nd coast brake (B1)
Poor acceleration (All positions)
1. Torque converter clutch
2. O/D planetary gear
Poor acceleration (O/D)
1. O/D direct clutch (C0)
2. O/D planetary gear
Large shift shock or engine stalls when starting off or stopping
1. Torque converter clutch
Author:
AX–26
AX–26
AX–26
Date:
642
DI–408
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI1J0–01
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft, which is rotated
by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear. After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular wave form by the wave form shaping circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the
ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pluse signals.
4–Pulse
4–Pulse
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Combination Meter
ECM
Transaxle
Vehicle Speed Sensor
A00414
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0500
During vehicle is being driven, no vehicle speed sensor signal
to ECM
(2 trip detection logic)
Clutch or brake slips or gear is broken
Trouble Area
Combination meter
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
ECM
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–145.
Author:
Date:
643
DI–409
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of speedometer.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the speedmeter in the combination meter is normal.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
NG
Check speedometer circuit. See combination
meter troubleshooting (See page BE–47).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove glove compartment (See page BO–75).
(b) Shift the shift lever to neutral.
(c) Jack up one of the front wheels.
(d) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and
body ground when the wheel is turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage is generated intermittently.
ON
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
SPD
(–)
(+)
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
SPD
(–)
(+)
0
A03021
Turn the wheel
D02238
NG
AT7809
Check and repair harness and connector
between combination meter and ECM
(See page IN–31).
OK
Author:
Date:
644
DI–410
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check the ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Replace the ECM.
OK
Check and repair the transaxle (clutch, brake
or gear etc.).
Author:
Date:
645
DI–411
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI032–02
DTC
P0750, P0755
Shift Solenoid A/B Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1/No.2)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor and crankshaft position sensor to detect the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
trouble of the shift solenoid valves, valve body or automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.).
DTC No.
P0750
P0755
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
During normal driving, the gear required by the ECM does not
match the actual gear
(2 trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
Check the shift solenoid valve No.1 when DTC P0750 is output and check the shift solenoid valve No.2 when
DTC P0755 is output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2 operation.
Q07741
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the oil pan.
(b) Remove the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
CHECK:
(a) By applying 490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) of compressed
air, check that the solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) When battery positive voltage is supplied to the shift solenoid valve, check that the valve opens.
OK:
(a) Solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) Solenoid valve opens.
NG
Replace the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
OK
Author:
Date:
646
DI–412
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check the valve body (See page DI–405).
NG
Repair or replace the valve body.
OK
Repair or replace the transaxle.
Author:
Date:
647
DI–413
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI033–02
DTC
P0753, P0758
Shift Solenoid A/B Electrical Malfunction (Shift Solenoid Valve No.1/No.2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to O/D is performed in combination with ON and OFF of the shift solenoid valves No.1 and
No.2 controlled by ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
Fail Safe Function:
If either of the shift solenoid valve circuits develops an open or short, the ECM turns the other shift solenoid
ON and OFF to shift to the gear positions shown in the table below. The ECM also turns the shift solenoid
valve SL OFF at the same time. If both solenoids are malfunction, hydraulic control cannot be performed
electronically and must be done manually.
Manual shifting as shown in the following table must be done (In the case of a short circuit, the ECM stops
sending current to the short circuited solenoid).
SHIFT SOLENOID NO.1
MALFUNCTIONING
NORMAL
Position
D
2
L
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
ON
OFF
ON
Gear
1st
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
ON
X
ON
2nd
X
OFF
ON
3rd
X
OFF
OFF
O/D
X
SHIFT SOLENOID NO.2
MALFUNCTIONING
Gear
BOTH SOLENOIDS MALFUNCTIONING
Gear when shift selector is
manually operated
3rd
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
X
ON
1st
O/D
3rd
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
ON
3rd
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
OFF
O/D
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
3rd
ON
X
1st
3rd
3rd
OFF
X
3rd
3rd
ON
Gear
ON
OFF
1st
X
ON
ON
ON
2nd
X
ON
OFF
ON
3rd
X
ON
3rd
OFF
X
3rd
3rd
ON
OFF
1st
X
OFF
1st
ON
X
1st
1st
ON
ON
2nd
X
ON
2nd
ON
X
1st
1st
X: Malfunctions
Check the shift solenoid valve No.1 when DTC P0753 is output and check the shift solenoid valve No.2 when
DTC P0758 is output.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0753
P0758
The ECM checks for an open or short circuit in the shift solenoid valves No.1 and No.2 circuit when it changes gear position.
The ECM records DTC P0753 or P0758 if condition (a) or (b) is
detected once, but it does not light up MIL.
After 1 sec. ECM detects condition (a) or (b) in a trip again, it
causes the MIL to light up.
Trouble Area
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2
ECM
(a) When the solenoid is energized, the solenoid resistance is
8 Ω or less and is counted.
(b) When the solenoid is not energized, the solenoid resistance
is 100 kΩ or more and is counted.
Author:
Date:
648
DI–414
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Transaxle
Shift Solenoid
Valve No.1
3
W
E4
Shift Solenoid
Valve No.2
*1:
w/ Engine
Immobiliser System
*2:
w/o Engine
Immobiliser System
1
B
E4
*2
*1
B+
7 8
S1
E9 E9
V
J25
Junction
Connector
L–B
L–B
A
A
A
*2
*1
B+
6 21
S2
E9 E9
Cruise Control ECU
D01807
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Measure resistance between terminal S1 or S2 of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from ECM.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal S1 or S2 of ECM and
body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 11 ∼ 15 Ω
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
S2
S1
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
S1
S2
Q10102
D00102
D00990
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
NG
Author:
Date:
649
DI–415
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check harness and connector between ECM and automatic transaxle solenoid
connector.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the solenoid connector from the automatic transaxle.
CHECK:
Check the harness and connector between terminal S1 or S2
of ECM and terminal S1 or S2 of solenoid connector.
OK:
There is no open and no short circuit.
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
S1
S2
S2
S1
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
S1
S1
S2
S2
D00958
D00104
D00991
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
650
DI–416
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the oil pan.
(c) Disconnect the solenoid connector.
(d) Remove the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
CHECK:
(a) Measure resistance between solenoid connector and
body ground.
(b) Connect the positive lead to terminal of solenoid connector, negative lead to solenoid body.
OK:
(a) Resistance: 11 ∼ 15 Ω
(b) The solenoid makes an operating noise.
Q07744
NG
Replace the shift solenoid valve.
OK
Repair or replace the solenoid wire.
Author:
Date:
651
DI–417
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI034–02
DTC
P0770
Shift Solenoid E Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Drain
Line
Pressure
Drain
Q07745
The ECM uses the signals from the Throttle position sensor,
Air–flow meter and Crankshaft position sensor to monitor the
engagement condition of the lock–up clutch.
Then the ECM compares the engagement condition of the
lock–up clutch with the lock–up schedule in the ECM memory
to detect mechanical trouble of the shift solenoid valve SL,
valve body, torque converter clutch or automatic transaxle
(clutch, brake or gear etc.).
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0770
Lock–up does not occur when driving in the lock–up range
(normal driving at 80 km/h [50 mph]), or lock–up remains ON
in the lock–up OFF range.
(2 trip detection logic)
When lock–up is ON, clutch or brake slips or gear is broken.
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or closed
Valve body blocked up or stuck
Lock–up clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check solenoid valve SL operation.
Q07746
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the oil pan.
(b) Remove the shift solenoid valve SL.
CHECK:
(a) By applying 490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) of compressed
air, check that the solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) When battery positive voltage is supplied to the shift solenoid valve, check that the solenoid valve opens.
OK:
(a) Solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) Solenoid valve opens.
NG
Replace the solenoid valve SL.
OK
Author:
Date:
652
DI–418
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check valve body (See page DI–405).
NG
Repair or replace the valve body.
OK
3
Check the torque converter clutch (See page AX–26).
NG
Replace the torque converter clutch.
OK
Repair or replace the transaxle.
Author:
Date:
653
DI–419
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI035–02
DTC
P0773
Shift Solenoid E Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The shift solenoid valve SL is turned ON and OFF by signals from the ECM to control the hydraulic pressure
acting on the lock–up relay valve, which then controls operation of the lock–up clutch.
Fail safe function
If the ECM detects a malfunction, it turns the shift solenoid valve SL OFF.
DTC No.
P0773
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Either (a) or (b) is detected for 1 time.(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Solenoid resistance is 8 Ω or less short circuit when solenoid is energized.
(b) Solenoid resistance is 100 kΩ or more open circuit when
solenoid is not energized.
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transaxle
ECM
B+
Shift Solenoid
Valve SL
1
E3
*1
: w/ Engine Immobiliser System
*2
: w/o Engine Immobiliser System
*1
P
*2
20 1
E9 E9
SL
D01808
Author:
Date:
654
DI–420
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Measure resistance between terminal SL of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from ECM.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal SL of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
Resistance: 11 ∼ 15 Ω
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
SL
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
SL
Q10099
Q07747
D00992
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
NG
Author:
Date:
655
DI–421
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check harness and connector between ECM and automatic transaxle solenoid
connector.
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
1
SL
2
SL
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the solenoid connector from the transaxle.
CHECK:
Check the harness and connector between terminal SL of ECM
and terminal SL of solenoid connector.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
SL
SL
D00937
Q07748
D00993
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
656
DI–422
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check shift solenoid valve SL.
Q07749
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the oil pan.
(c) Disconnect the shift solenoid valve SL connector.
(d) Remove the shift solenoid valve SL.
CHECK:
(a) Measure resistance between terminal SL of shift solenoid
valve and solenoid body.
(b) Connect positive lead to terminal of solenoid connector, negative lead to solenoid body.
OK:
(a) Resistance: 11 ∼ 15 Ω
(b) The shift solenoid valve SL makes operation
noise.
NG
Replace the shift solenoid valve SL.
OK
Check and replace or repair the solenoid
wire.
Author:
Date:
657
DI–423
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI036–02
DTC
P1520
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The purpose of this circuit is to prevent the engine from stalling, while driving in lock–up condition, when
brakes are suddenly applied.
When the brake pedal is depressed, this switch sends a signal to ECM. Then the ECM cancels operation
of the lock–up clutch while braking is in progress.
DTC No.
P1520
DTC Detecting Condition
No stop light switch signal to ECM during driving.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Open or short in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–170.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
See page DI–170.
Author:
Date:
658
DI–424
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI037–02
DTC
P1780
Park/Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever position and sends signals to the ECM.
The ECM receives signals (NSW, R, 2 and L) from the park/neutral position switch. When the signal is not
sent to the ECM from the park/neutral position switch, the ECM judges that the shift lever is in D position.
DTC No.
P1780
DTC Detection Condition
When driving under conditions (a) and (b) for 30 seconds or
more, the park/neutral position switch is ON (N position).
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 80 km/h (50 mph) or more
(b) Engine speed: 2,000 ∼ 5,000 rpm
Trouble Area
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
Author:
Date:
659
DI–425
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination
Meter
ECM
8
R
R–B
C8
11
C8
6
C8
2
L
*3
*4
13
O
IG13
16
Y
1V
Junction
5
II2
Y
E
3
P1
L–W
8
P1
R–L
6
II2
R–B
Junction
Y
3
II3
D
D
*4 O
C
C J27 A
J27
J28
R–B
2 II2
F
18
E7
*3 L – W
L
*1
*2
D
Connector
*3 L – W
*4 O
R–B
*1
19 15
E7 E7
Y
E
E
J29
2
P1
R–L
5
*2
Connector
4
P1
A
1H 10
J29
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
A
L–W
O
Y
IG13
J21
Junction
Connector
Instrument
Panel J/B
R–B
16
E7
2
17
E7
R
B+
J27, J28
R–L
6
5
Junction Connector
11
II2
B–W
B
J29
Junction B
Connector
GR
R–L
F
J28
Junction
Connector
B–R
1
1B
AM1
2
1K
Ignition Switch
4
2
I16
I16
W
B–Y
22
E7
B–W
B
B–W
NSW
B–W
1
1K
GAUGE
1
1J
B–R
1 F9 2 F9
ALT
1 F4 1 F6
B–G
FL
B
MAIN
Battery
Instrument Panel J/B
5
1K
5
1B
Instrument Panel J/B
7
I16
W–R
8
I16
AM2
1
2A
STARTER
3
1J
Engine Room J/B No.2
B
3
2B
Engine Room J/B No.2
J7 J8 Junction Connector
*5
C
B
10
GR
J8
J7
II2
*6
B–O
4
1K
Instrument Panel J/B
W – R Instrument Panel J/B
4
2L
R
11
2J
MAIN
5
ST Relay
3
1
2
5
2D
9
2K
Starter
J11 Junction Connector
A
*5
GR
IK
*6
B–O
*1: w/ Engine Immobiliser System *4: TMMK Made
*2: w/o Engine Immobiliser System *5: TMC Made w/o Traction Control
*3: TMC Made
*6: Except TMC Made w/o Traction Control
Author:
Date:
D01820
660
DI–426
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Read PNP, REVERSE, 2ND and LOW signals.
When using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the DLC3 cover.
(b) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Shift the shift lever into the P, R, N, 2 and L positions, and read
the PNP, REVERSE, 2ND and LOW signals on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
OK:
ON
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
L
(–)
(+)
R
(–)
BE3840
Q08479
D00043
(+)
NSW
L 2
D00994
Signal
2
2ND OFF → ON
L
LOW OFF → ON
R
REVERSE OFF → ON
P, N
PNP OFF → ON
When not using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals NSW, 2, L and R of ECM
and body ground when the shift lever is shifted in the following
positions.
OK:
NSW R 2
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
Shift position
Position
NSW–Body
ground
R–Body
ground
2–Body
ground
L–Body
ground
P, N
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
R
9 ∼ 14 V*
D
9 ∼ 14 V
0V
2
9 ∼ 14 V
0V
L
9 ∼ 14 V
0V
9 ∼ 14 V*
9 ∼ 14 V
0V
0V
9 ∼ 14 V
HINT:
The voltage will drop slightly due to lighting up of the back up
light.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page DI–405).
NG
Author:
Date:
661
DI–427
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check park/neutral position switch.
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the park/neutral position switch.
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal shown below when the
shift lever is moved to each position.
Shift Position
Terminal No. to continuity
Terminal No. to continuity
P
4–7
5–6
R
4–8
–
N
4 – 10
5–6
D
4–9
–
2
2–4
–
L
2–3
–
Q07657
OK:
There is continuity.
NG
Replace the park/neutral position switch.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between battery and park/neutral position switch,
park/neutral position switch and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace the harness and connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Author:
Date:
662
DI–428
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI038–02
O/D Cancel Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
While driving uphill with cruise control activated, in order to minimize gear shifting and provide smooth cruising overdrive may be prohibited temporarily under some conditions.
The cruise control ECU sends O/D cut signals to the ECM as necessary and the ECM cancels overdrive
shifting until these signals are discontinued.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Cruise Control ECU
B+
OD
*1
*2
14
C15
*2
Y–B
*1
20 18 OD1
E7 E7
: w/ Engine Immobiliser System
: w/o Engine Immobiliser System
D01809
Author:
Date:
663
DI–429
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal OD1 of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal OD1 of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
OD1
(+)
(–)
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
OD1
BE3840
Q07658
D00103
D00995
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page DI–405).
NG
2
Check voltage between terminal OD of cruise control ECU harness side connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the cruise control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal OD of cruise control ECU
harness side connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
(–)
BE3840
I00143
(+)
OD
D00057
OK
Check and replace the cruise control ECU.
NG
Author:
Date:
664
DI–430
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and ECM.
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Author:
Date:
665
DI–431
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
DI1J1–01
O/D Main Switch & O/D OFF Indictor Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The O/D main switch contacts go open when the switch is pushed in and go closed when it is pushed out.
In O/D main switch in OFF position, the O/D OFF indicator light lights up, and the ECM prohibits shifting overdrive.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument
Panel J/B
2
1
AM1
1K
1B
1
2
W
Ignition Switch
2
4
I16
I16
AM1 IG1
ECM
Instrument
Panel J/B
2 GAUGE
1D
1
1K
B+
B–Y
*1
G–O
B–R
*2
5 7
E7 E7
OD2
R–L
J4
Junction
Connector
D
B–R
O/D OFF
11 IG3
Indicator Light
(Combination Meter)
G–O
7
12
C J6
R–L
G – OC
Junction
C8
C8
D
C Connector
G–O
2 O2
1 F9
FUSIBLE
LINK
BLOCK
2 F9
O/D Main
Switch
ALT
1 F4
(*3)
FL
MAIN
B–G
4 O2
W–B
A
J5
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
Battery
IF
*1
*2
*3
: w/ Engine Immobiliser System
: w/o Engine Immobiliser System
: O/D Main Switch
Contacts go open with switch pushed in
Contacts go closed with switch pushed once again
D01810
Author:
Date:
666
DI–432
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
O/D OFF indicator light does not light up
1
Check O/D main switch.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the O/D main switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity at each terminal 2 and 4 of O/D main switch
connector.
OK:
2
4
Q07595
NG
O/D main switch
Specified condition
ON
No continuity
OFF
Continuity
Replace the O/D main switch.
OK
2
Check and replace combination meter (See page BE–47).
NG
Replace the combination meter.
OK
Author:
Date:
667
DI–433
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check OVRDRIVE CUT SW2 signal.
When using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the DLC3 cover.
(b) Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the OVRDRIVE CUT SW2 signal on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
OK:
O/D main switch condition
OVRDRIVE CUT SW2 signal
O/D ON (Pushed in)
OFF
O/D OFF (Pushed once again)
ON
When not using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check voltage between terminal OD2 of ECM and body ground.
OK:
ON
w/ Engine Immobiliser System
OD2
(–)
O/D main switch condition
Voltage
O/D ON (Pushed in)
9 ∼ 14
O/D OFF (Pushed once again)
Below 1.5 V
(+)
w/o Engine Immobiliser System
OD2
BE3840
Q07661
Q07754
D01716
OK
Check and replace the ECM
(See page IN–31).
NG
Author:
Date:
668
DI–434
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Check harness and connector between O/D OFF indicator light and ECM
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
669
DI–435
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
O/D OFF indicator light remains ON
1
Check O/D main switch.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the O/D main switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity at each terminal 2 and 4 of O/D main switch
connector.
OK:
2
4
Q07595
NG
O/D main switch
Specified condition
ON
No continuity
OFF
Continuity
Replace the O/D main switch.
OK
2
Check harness and connector between O/D OFF indicator light and O/D main
switch, O/D OFF indicator light and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
670
DI–436
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02C–02
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manual, with the
page number indicated in the bottom portion. See the indicated
pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–437
2
Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
If the display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE” when you have connected the
scan tool / TOYOTA hand–held tester, inspect DLC3 P. DI–438
3
Check DTC and Freezes Frame Data (Pre–check)
Record or Print DTC and Freezed Frame Data P. DI–438
4
Clear DTC and Freezed Frame Data P. DI–449
5 Visual Inspection
6 Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis P. DI–438
symptom does not occur
8
7 Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
symptom occur
9
DTC Check
P. DI–438
10
DTC Chart
P. DI–449
OK Code 11
OK
Mechanical System Test
P. DI–438
NG 12
13
OK
Manual Shifting Test
P. DI–438
NG
NG
Matrix Chart of Problem Symptoms – P. DI–453
Chapter 1
(Electronic)
P. DI–453
NG
14
Preliminary Check NG
P. DI–438
Chapter 2
(On–Vehicle)
P. DI–453
OK
NG
16
Repair
Chapter 3
(Off–Vehicle)
P. DI–453
NG
15 Parts Inspection
Main Throttle Signal Check
Circuit
Stop Light Signal Check
Inspection
P. DI–484 to DI–487
Identification of Problem
OK
17
Confirmation Test
Author:
End
Date:
671
DI–437
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02D–01
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Transaxle Control
System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
:
Registration No.
Customer’s Name
Registration Year
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem
Occurred
How Often Does
Problem Occur?
/
km
mile
Odometer Reading
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
Vehicle does not move ( Any position
No up–shift
( 1st → 2nd
No down–shift
( O/D → 3rd
times a day)
Particular position )
2nd → 3rd
3rd → 2nd
3rd → O/D )
2nd → 1st )
Lock–up malfunction
Symptoms
Shift point too high or too low
Harsh engagement ( N → D
Lock–up
Any drive position )
Slip or shudder
No kick–down
Others
Check Item
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Normal
Remains ON
DTC Check
1st Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (Code
)
Author:
Date:
672
DI–438
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02E–02
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
FI0534
TOYOTA hand–held tester
DLC3
S05335
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure
is that you connect to the vehicle an OBD II scan
tool complying with SAE J1987 or TOYOTA hand–
held tester, and read off various data output from
the vehicle’s ECM.
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s on–
board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the computer itself or
in drive system components which affect vehicle
emissions. In addition to the MIL lighting up when
a malfunction is detected, the applicable DTCs prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the ECM
memory. (See page DI–211)
If the malfunction only occurs in 3 trips, the MIL goes
off but the DTCs remain recorded in the ECM
memory.
To check the DTCs, connect an OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 on the vehicle.
The OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester
also enables you to erase the DTCs and check
freeze frame data and various forms of engine data
(For instruction book).
DTCs include SAE controlled codes and Manufacturer controlled codes.
SAE controlled codes must be set as prescribed by
the SAE, while Manufacturer controlled codes can
be set freely by the manufacturer within the prescribed limits (See DTC chart on page DI–449).
Author:
Date:
673
DI–439
DIAGNOSTICS
–
(b)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode
during normal vehicle use, and also has a check
mode for technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms and perform troubleshooting. Most DTCs use
2 trip detection logic(*) to prevent erroneous detection. By switching the ECM to check mode when
troubleshooting, the technician can cause the MIL
to light up and for a malfunction that is only detected
once or momentarily.
(TOYOTA hand–held tester) (See page DI–438)
*2 trip detection logic:
When a logic malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is temporarily stored in the ECM memory.
If the same malfunction is detected again during the
2nd test drive, this 2nd detection causes the MIL to
light up.
Inspect the DLC3.
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141–2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE
J1962 and matches the ISO 9141–2 format.
N09214
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
7 (Bus Line) – 5 (Signal ground)
During communication
4 (Chassis Ground) – Body
Always
1 Ω or less
5 (Signal Ground) – Body
Always
1 Ω or less
16 (B+) – Body
Always
9 – 14 V
Pulse generation
HINT:
If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE”
when you have connected the cable of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON
and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle
side or tool side.
(1) If communication is normal when the tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect DLC3 on the original vehicle.
(2) If communication is still not possible when the tool
is connected connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tool itself, so consult the
Service Department listed in the tool’s instruction
manual.
Author:
Date:
674
DI–440
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
FI0534
TOYOTA hand–held tester
HINT:
If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter
(See page BE–2).
(2) When the engine is started, the MIL should go off.
If the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system has
detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
(b) Check the DTC.
NOTICE:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only:
When the diagnostic system is switched from normal mode
to check mode, it erases all DTCs and freeze frame data recorded in normal mode. So before switching modes, always check the DTCs and freeze frame data, and note them
down.
(1) Prepare an OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
(2)
(4)
S05335
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (NORMAL MODE)
Check the MIL.
(1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned
ON and the engine is not running.
(3)
DLC3
–
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester to DLC3 at the lower of the instrument
panel.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester switch ON.
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to check the DTCs and freeze frame data and
note them down (For operating instructions, see the
OBD II scan tool’s instruction book).
See page DI–449 to confirm the details of the DTCs.
(5)
NOTICE:
When simulating symptoms with an OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) to check the DTCs, use
normal mode. For codes on the DTCs chart subject to ”2
trip detection logic”, turn the ignition switch off after the
symptoms have been simulated the 1st time. Them repeat
the simulation process again. When the program has DTCs
are recorded in the ECM.
Author:
Date:
675
DI–441
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
3.
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (CHECK MODE)
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only: Compared to the normal
mode, the check mode has high sensing ability to detect malfunctions. Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are
detected in Normal mode can also be detected in Check mode.
(a) Check the DTC.
(1) Check the initial conditions.
Battery positive voltage 11 V or more.
Throttle valve fully closed.
Transaxle in P position.
Air conditioning switched off.
(2) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(3) Prepare a TOYOTA hand–held tester.
TOYOTA hand–held tester
(4)
(5)
DLC3
S05335
(6)
0.13 sec.
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 at
the lower of the instrument panel.
Turn the ignition switch ON and switch the TOYOTA
hand–held tester ON.
(7)
0.13 sec.
ON
(8)
OFF
BR3904
Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from Normal
mode to Check mode (Check that the MIL flashes).
Start the engine (MIL goes out after the engine
starts).
Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by the customer.
NOTICE:
Leave the ignition switch ON until you have checked the
DTCs, etc..
(9) After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
TOYOTA hand–held tester diagnosis selector to
check the DTCs and freeze frame data, etc..
HINT:
Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF, as turning it off
switches the diagnosis system from Check mode to Normal
mode, so all DTCs, etc. are erased.
(10) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
Author:
Date:
676
DI–442
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Clearance the DTC.
The following actions will erase the DTC and freezed
frame data. Operating an OBD II scan tool (complying
with SAE J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase
the codes.
(See the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book for operating
instructions.)
4.
ROAD TEST
NOTICE:
Perform the test at normal operating ATF temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
(a) D POSITION TEST
Shift into the D position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and and check the following points:
(1) Check up–shift operation.
1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D up–shift takes place, at the shift point shown in the automatic shift
schedule (See page SS–56).
HINT:
O/D Gear Up–shift Prohibition Control (1. Coolant temp. is 60 °C (140 °F) or less. 2. If there is a 10
km/h (6 mph) difference between the set cruise control speed and vehicle speed.)
O/D Gear Lock–up Prohibition Control (1. Brake pedal is depressed. 2. Coolant temp. is 60 °C
(140 °F) or less.)
(2) Check for shift shock and slip.
Check for shock and slip at the 1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D up–shifts.
(3) Check for abnormal noises and vibration.
Run at the D position lock–up or O/D gear and check for abnormal noises and vibration.
HINT:
The check for the cause of abnormal noises and vibration must be done very thoroughly as it could also be
due to loss of balance in the differential torque converter clutch, etc..
(4) Check kick–down operation.
While running in the D position, 2nd, 3rd and O/D gears, check to see that the possible kick–down
vehicle speed limits for 2 → 1, 3 → 2 and O/D → 3 kick–downs conform to those indicated on
the automatic shift schedule (See page SS–56).
(5) Check abnormal shock and slip at kick–down.
(6) Check the lock–up mechanism.
Drive in D position, O/D gear, at a steady speed (lock–up ON) of about 60 km/h (37 mph).
Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check that the engine speed does not change
abruptly.
If there is a big jump in engine speed, there is no lock–up.
(b) 2 POSITION TEST
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points:
(1) Check up–shift operation.
Check to see that the 1 → 2 up–shift takes place and that the shift point conforms to the automatic
shift schedule (See page SS–56).
HINT:
There is no O/D up–shift and lock–up in the 2 position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the 2 position and 2nd gear, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine
braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration, and for shock at up–shift and
down–shift.
Author:
Date:
677
DI–443
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
(c)
L POSITION TEST
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points:
(1) Check no up–shift.
While running in the L position, check that there is no up–shift to 2nd gear.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the L position, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration.
(d) R POSITION TEST
Shift into the R position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check for slipping.
CAUTION:
Before conducting this test ensure that the test area is free from people and obstruction.
(e) P POSITION TEST
Stop the vehicle on a grade (more than 5°) and after shifting into the P position, release the parking
brake. Then, check to see that the parking lock pawl holds the vehicle in place.
Q00519
5.
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Check the fluid level.
HINT:
Drive the vehicle so that the engine and transaxle are at
normal operating temperature.
Fluid temp.: 70 – 80 °C (158 – 176 °F)
Only use the COOL range on the dipstick as a rough reference when the fluid is replaced or the engine does not
run.
(1)
OK if hot
Add if hot
AT3417
Park the vehicle on a level surface and set the parking brake.
(2) With the engine idling and the brake pedal depressed, shift the shift lever into all positions from P
to L position and return to P position.
(3) Pull out the dipstick and wipe it clean.
(4) Push it back fully into the pipe.
(5) Pull it out and check that the fluid level is in the HOT
range.
If the level is at the low side, add new fluid.
Fluid type: ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
NOTICE:
Do not overfill.
(b) Check the fluid condition.
If the level is at the low side, add new fluid.
Author:
Date:
678
DI–444
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Replace the ATF.
(1) Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid.
(2) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
AT4657
(3)
With the engine OFF add new fluid through the oil
filler pipe.
Fluid type: ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
Capacity: 3.9 liters (4.1 US qts, 3.4 Imp. qts)
(4) Start the engine and shift the shift lever into all positions from P to L position and then shift into P position.
AT8562
(5)
OK if hot
(6)
Add if hot
AT3417
0 ∼ 1 mm (0 ∼ 0.04 in.)
With the engine idling, check the fluid level. Add
fluid up to the COOL level on the dipstick.
Check the fluid level at the normal operating temperature, 70 – 80 °C (158 – 176 °F), and add as
necessary.
NOTICE:
Do not overfill.
(d) Check the fluid leaks.
Check for leaks in the transaxle.
If there are leaks, it is necessary to repair or replace O–rings,
gasket, oil seals, plugs or other parts.
(e)
Inspect and adjust the throttle cable.
(1) Check that the accelerator pedal is fully released.
(2) Check that the inner cable is not slack.
(3) Measure the distance between the outer cable end
and stopper on the cable.
Standard distance: 0 – 1 mm (0 – 0.04 in.)
If the distance is not the standard, adjust the cable by the adjusting nuts.
AT4252
Author:
Date:
679
DI–445
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
(f)
Q00199
Inspect and adjust the shift lever position.
When shifting the shift lever from the N position to other
positions, check that the lever can be shifted smoothly
and accurately to each position and that the position indicator is not aligned with the correct position.
If the indicator is not aligned with the correct position, carry out
the following adjustment procedures.
(1) Loosen the nut on the shift lever.
(2) Push the control shaft fully rearward.
(3)
Q04604
Neutral Basic Line
Bolt
Groove
Bolt
Q04700
Return the control shaft lever 2 notches to N position.
(4) Set the shift lever to N position.
(5) While holding the shift lever lightly toward the R
position side, tighten the shift lever nut.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(6) Start the engine and make sure that the vehicle
moves forward when shifting the lever from the N to
D position and reverses when shifting it to the R
position.
(g) Inspect and adjust the park/neutral position.
Check that the engine can be started with the shift lever
only in the N or P position, but not in other positions.
If it is not as stated above, carry out the following adjustment
procedures.
(1) Loosen the park/neutral position switch bolt and set
the shift lever to the N position.
(2) Align the groove and neutral basic line.
(3) Hold in position and tighten the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in·lbf)
For continuity inspection of the park/neutral position
switch, see page DI–479.
(h) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
(In N position and air conditioner OFF)
6.
(a)
MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
Measure the stall speed.
The object of this test is to check the overall performance of the transaxle and engine by measuring
the stall speeds in the D and R positions.
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
Do not continuously run this test longer than 5 seconds.
To ensure safety, conduct this test in a wide, clear level area which provides good traction.
The stall test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
(1) Chock the 4 wheels.
(2) Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(3) Fully apply the parking brake.
(4) Keep your left foot pressed firmly on the brake pedal.
(5) Start the engine.
Author:
Date:
680
DI–446
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
(6)
Shift into the D position. Press all the way down on the accelerator pedal with your right foot.
Quickly read the stall speed at this time.
Stall speed: 2,600 ± 150 rpm
(7) Do the same test in R position.
Stall speed: 2,600 ± 150 rpm
Evaluation:
Problem
Possible cause
(a) Stall speed low in D and R positions
Engine output may be insufficient
Stator one–way clutch is operating properly
HINT: If more than 600 rpm below the specified value, the torque
converter could be faulty.
(b) Stall speed high in D position
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch slipping
No.2 one–way clutch not operating properly
O/D clutch slipping
(c) Stall speed high in R position
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch slipping
1st and reverse brake slipping
O/D clutch slipping
(d) Stall speed high in D and R positions
Line pressure too low
Improper fluid level
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
(b)
Measure the time lag.
When the shift lever is shifted while the engine is idling, there will be a certain time lapse or lag before
the shock can be felt. This is used for checking the condition of the O/D direct clutch, forward clutch,
and 1st and reverse brake.
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
Be sure to allow 1 minute interval between tests.
Take 3 measurements and take the average value.
(1) Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(2) Fully apply the parking brake.
(3) Start the engine and check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm (In N position and air conditioner OFF)
(4) Shift the shift lever from N to D position. Using a stop watch, measure the time from when the
lever is shifted until the shock is felt.
In the same manner, measure the time lag for N → R.
Time lag:
N → D Less than 1.2 seconds
N → R Less than 1.5 seconds
Evaluation (If N → D time or N → R time lag is longer than specified):
Problem
Possible cause
N → D time lag is longer
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch worn
O/D one–way clutch not operating
N → R time lag is longer
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch worn
1st and reverse brake worn
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
Author:
Date:
681
DI–447
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
7.
HYDRAULIC TEST
Measure the line pressure
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operation fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
The line pressure test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe
the conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
Be careful to prevent SST’s hose from interfering with the exhaust pipe.
(1) Warm up the ATF.
(2) Remove the test plug on the transaxle case front left side and connect SST.
(See page AX–21 for the location to connect SST)
SST 09992–00095 (09992–00231, 09992–00271)
(3) Fully apply the parking brake and chock the 4 wheels.
(4) Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
(5) Start the engine and check idling speed.
(6) Keep your left foot pressed firmly on the brake pedal and shift into D position.
(7) Measure the line pressure when the engine is idling.
(8) Depress the accelerator pedal all the way down. Quickly read the highest line pressure when
engine speed reaches stall speed.
(9) In the same manner, do the test in R position.
Specified line pressure:
Condition
D position
kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
R position
kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
Idling
401 – 461 (4.1 – 4.7, 58 – 66)
804 – 882 (8.2 – 9.0, 117 – 128)
Stall
1,138 – 1,236 (11.6 – 12.6, 165 – 179)
1,716 – 1,854 (17.5 – 18.9, 249 – 269)
If the measured pressure is not up to specified value, recheck the throttle cable adjustment and retest.
Evaluation
Problem
Possible cause
If the measured values at all position are higher
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
If the measured values at all position are lower
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
Oil pump defective
O/D direct clutch defective
If pressure is low in the D position only
D position circuit fluid leakage
Forward clutch defective
If pressure is low in the R position only
R position circuit fluid leakage
Direct clutch defective
1st and reverse brake defective
Author:
Date:
682
DI–448
DIAGNOSTICS
Q00224
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
8.
MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
HINT:
With this test, it can be determined whether the trouble is within
the electrical circuit or is a mechanical problem in the transaxle.
(a) Disconnect the solenoid wire.
(b) Inspect the manual driving operation.
Check that the shift and gear positions correspond with
the table below.
While driving, shift through the L, 2 and D positions.
Check that the gear change corresponds to the shift position.
Shift Position
Gear Position
D
O/D
2
O/D
L
1st
R
Reverse
P
Pawl Lock
HINT:
If the L, 2 and D position gear positions are difficult to positions
are difficult to distinguish, do the following read test.
If any abnormality is found in the above test, the problem is in
the transaxle itself.
(c) Connect the solenoid wire.
(d) Cancel out the DTC (See page DI–438).
Author:
Date:
683
DI–449
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02F–02
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a DTC is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table below and proceed to the page given.
* : –...MIL does not light /...MIL light up
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL *
Memory
P0500
(DI–456)
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
(No.1 Vehicle Speed Sensor)
Open or short in No.1 vehicle speed sensor circuit
No.1 vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0750
(DI–460)
Shift Solenoid A Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1)
Shift solenoid valve No.1 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0753
(DI–462)
Shift Solenoid A Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.1
ECM
P0755
(DI–460)
Shift Solenoid B Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.2)
Shift solenoid valve No.2 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0758
(DI–462)
Shift Solenoid B Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.2)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.2
ECM
P0770
(DI–466)
Shift Solenoid E Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Lock–up clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0773
(DI–468)
Shift Solenoid E Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL
ECM
P1520
(DI–472)
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
Open or short in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
P1705
(DI–473)
NC2 Revolution Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
(Direct Clutch Speed Sensor)
Open or short in direct clutch speed sensor circuit
Direct clutch speed sensor
ECM
P1765
(DI–476)
Linear Solenoid for Accumulator
Pressure Control Circuit Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SLN)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLN circuit
Shift solenoid valve SLN
ECM
P1780
(DI–479)
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Malfunction
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
Author:
Date:
684
DI–450
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02G–02
PARTS LOCATION
Throttle Position Sensor
Cruise Control ECU
O/D Main Switch
ECM
O/D OFF Indicator LIght
DLC3
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
Crankshaft Position
Sensor
DLC2
Stop Light Switch
Direct Clutch Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Shift Solenoid Valve SL
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Shift Solenoid Valve SLN
Shift Solenoid Valve No.1, No2
Q07932
Author:
Date:
685
DI–451
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI1KA–01
TERMINALS OF ECM
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC:
ECM Terminals
E10
E9
E8
E7
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
16 15
14 13
12 11
26 25 24 23 22 2120 19 18 17
3433 3231
30 2928 27
11 10 9
8 7
7
17 16 15 14 13 12
22 2120
19 18
6 5
11 10 9 8
16 15 14 13 12
13 12
11
10 9
21 2019 18 1716 15 14
28 27 26 25
24 23 22
FI6810
Symbols (Terminals No.)
S1 ↔ E1 (E10–11
(E10 11 ↔ E8
E8–16)
16)
S2 ↔ E1 (E10
(E10–17
17 ↔ E8
E8–16)
16)
SL ↔ E1 (E10–27
(E10 27 ↔ E8
E8–16)
16)
NC2+ ↔ NC2– (E9–9 ↔ E9–4)
SLN+ ↔ SLN–
(E10–2 ↔ E 8–2)
OD1 ↔ E1 (E7–7 ↔ E8–16)
OD2 ↔ E1 (E7–6
(E7 6 ↔ E8–16)
E8 16)
Wiring Color
V ↔ BR
L–B
L
B ↔ BR
P L ↔ BR
P–L
R↔G
Condition
IG ON
10 ∼ 14
1st or 2nd gear
10 ∼ 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
1st or 2nd gear
10 ∼ 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
Vehicle driving under lock–up position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON
Y–B ↔ BR
IG ON
L ↔ E1 (E7–1
(E7 1 ↔ E8–16)
E8 16)
Y ↔ BR
2 ↔ E1 (E7–10
(E7 10 ↔ E8–16)
E8 16)
*1,
1, *3
3L
L–W
W ↔ BR
*2, *4 O ↔ BR
R ↔ E1 (E7–15
(E7 15 ↔ E8–16)
E8 16)
R B ↔ BR
R–B
NSW ↔ E1
(E10–14 ↔ E8–16)
B W ↔ BR
B–W
Pulse signal is output
Below 1 ↔ 4 ∼ 5
Engine is running
W–L ↔ B–Y
G O ↔ BR
G–O
STD Voltage (V)
10 ∼ 14
5∼6
O/D main switch ON
10 ∼ 14
O/D main switch OFF
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever L position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever other than L position
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever 2 position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever other than 2 position
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever R position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever other than R position
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever P or N position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever other than P or N position
Below 1
*1: w/ Engine immobilizer system
*2: w/o Engine immobilizer system
*3 TMC made ex. USA w/ TRAC
*4: TMMK made, TMC made USA w/ TRAC
Author:
Date:
686
DI–452
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC:
ECM Terminals
E11
E10
E9
E8
E7
D01054
Symbols (Terminals No.)
S1 ↔ E1 (E11–7
(E11 7 ↔ E10
E10–17)
17)
S2 ↔ E1 (E11–8
(E11 8 ↔ E10
E10–17)
17)
SL ↔ E1 (E11–9
(E11 9 ↔ E10
E10–17)
17)
Wiring Color
V ↔ BR
L–B
L
B ↔ BR
P L ↔ BR
P–L
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
IG ON
10 ∼ 14
1st or 2nd gear
10 ∼ 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
1st or 2nd gear
10 ∼ 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
Vehicle driving under lock–up position
10 ∼ 14
↔
(E11–14 ↔ E11–26)
R↔G
SLN+ ↔ SLN–
(E11–20 ↔ E11–19)
W–L ↔ B–Y
IG ON
10 ∼ 14
OD1 ↔ E1 (E8–24 ↔ E10–17)
Y–B ↔ BR
IG ON
5∼6
OD2 ↔ E1 (E8–10
(E8 10 ↔ E10–17)
E10 17)
G O ↔ BR
G–O
NC2+
NC2–
L ↔ E1 (E8–12
(E8 12 ↔ E10–17)
E10 17)
Y ↔ BR
2 ↔ E1 (E8–3
(E8 3 ↔ E10–17)
E10 17)
*1,
1, *3
3L
L–W
W ↔ BR
*2, *4 O ↔ BR
R ↔ E1 (E8–2
(E8 2 ↔ E10–17)
E10 17)
R B ↔ BR
R–B
NSW ↔ E1
(E8–20 ↔ E10–17)
B W ↔ BR
B–W
Pulse signal is output
Below 1 ↔ 4 ∼ 5
Engine is running
O/D main switch ON
10 ∼ 14
O/D main switch OFF
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever L position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever other than L position
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever 2 position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever other than 2 position
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever R position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever other than R position
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever P or N position
10 ∼ 14
IG ON and Shift lever other than P or N position
Below 1
*1: w/ Engine immobilizer system
*2: w/o Engine immobilizer system
*3 TMC made ex. USA w/ TRAC
*4: TMMK made, TMC made USA w/ TRAC
Author:
Date:
687
DI–453
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02I–02
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal code is displayed during the diagnostic trouble code check but the trouble still occurs, check the
circuits for each symptom in the order given in the charts on the following pages and proceed to the page
given for troubleshooting.
The Matrix Chart is divided into 3 chapters.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Chapter 2: On–vehicle Repair Matrix Chart
Chapter 3: Off–vehicle repair Matrix Chart
If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the flow chart
for each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to continue the check.
If the trouble still occurs even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits, then check
and replace the ECM.
1.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
No up–shift (1st → 2nd)
ECM
No up–shift (2nd → 3rd)
ECM
IN–31
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
1. O/D main switch circuit
2. O/D cancel signal circuit
3. ECM
DI–487
DI–484
IN–31
No down–shift (O/D → 3rd)
ECM
IN–31
No down–shift (3rd → 2nd)
ECM
IN–31
No down–shift (2nd → 1st)
ECM
IN–31
No lock–up or No lock–up off
ECM
IN–31
Shift point too high or too low
ECM
IN–31
Up–shift to 2nd while in L position
ECM
IN–31
Up–shift to 3rd while in L position
ECM
IN–31
Up–shift to O/D from 3rd
1. O/D main switch circuit
2. ECM
DI–487
IN–31
Up–shift to O/D from 3rd while engine is cold
ECM
IN–31
Harsh engagement (N → D)
ECM
IN–31
Harsh engagement (Lock–up)
ECM
IN–31
Harsh engagement (Any driving position)
ECM
IN–31
Poor acceleration
ECM
IN–31
Large shift shock or engine stalls when starting off or stopping
ECM
IN–31
IN–31
Author:
Date:
688
DI–454
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Chapter 2: On–Vehicle Repair
(: A541E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM530U)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Vehicle does not move in any forward position and reverse position
1. Manual valve
2. Throttle valve
3. Primary regulator valve
4. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
Vehicle does not move in R position
Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
No up–shift (1st → 2nd)
1. 1–2 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
No up–shift (2nd → 3rd)
1. 2–3 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
1. 3–4 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
No down–shift (O/D → 3rd)
3–4 shift valve
No down–shift (3rd → 2nd)
2–3 shift valve
No down–shift (2nd → 1st)
1–2 shift valve
No lock–up or No lock–up off
1. Lock–up relay valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1. C1 accumulator
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
Harsh engagement (N → R)
1. C2 accumulator
2. No.1 accumulator control valve
3. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
Harsh engagement (N → L)
Low coast modulator valve
Harsh engagement (Lock–up)
1. Lock–up relay valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
Harsh engagement (1st → 2nd → 3rd → O/D)
1. Throttle modulator valve
2. Cut back valve
3. Throttle valve
Harsh engagement (2nd → 3rd)
C2 accumulator
Harsh engagement (3rd → O/D)
B0 accumulator
Harsh engagement (O/D → 3rd)
1. C0 accumulator
2. B0 accumulator
Slip or shudder (Forward and reverse)
1. Throttle valve
2. Oil strainer
3. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
No engine braking (1st: L position)
1. Low coast modulator valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
No engine braking (2nd: 2 position)
1. 2nd coast modulator valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
DI–453
No kick–down
1. 1–2 shift valve
2. 2–3 shift valve
3. 3–4 shift valve
DI–453
Author:
Date:
689
DI–455
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Chapter 3: Off–Vehicle Repair
(: A541E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM530U)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Vehicle does not move in any forward position and reverse position
1. Front and rear planetary gear
2. O/D planetary gear
3. O/D one–way clutch (F0)
4. O/D direct clutch (C0)
5. Forward clutch (C1)
6. O/D brake (B0)
Vehicle does not move in R position
1. Front and rear planetary gear unit
2. Direct clutch (C2)
3. O/D direct clutch (C0)
4. 1st and reverse brake (B3)
No up–shift (1st → 2nd)
1. No. 1 one–way clutch (F1)
2. 2nd brake (B2)
No up–shift (2nd → 3rd)
Direct clutch (C2)
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
O/D brake (B0)
No lock–up or No lock–up off
Torque converter clutch
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1. Forward clutch (C1)
2. O/D one–way clutch (F0)
3. No. 2 one–way clutch (F2)
Harsh engagement (N → R)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
2. 1st and reverse brake (B3)
Harsh engagement (Lock–up)
Torque converter clutch
Slip or shudder (Forward position: After warm–up)
1. Torque converter clutch
2. O/D direct clutch (C0)
3. Forward clutch (C1)
4. O/D one–way clutch (F0)
Slip or shudder (R position)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
2. 1st and reverse brake (B3)
3. O/D direct clutch (C0)
Slip or shudder (1st)
No. 2 one–way clutch (F2)
Slip or shudder (2nd)
1. No. 1 one–way clutch (F1)
2. 2nd brake (B2)
Slip or shudder (3rd)
Direct clutch (C2)
Slip or shudder (O/D)
O/D brake (B0)
No engine braking (1st ∼ 3rd: D position)
2nd brake (B2)
No engine braking (1st: L position)
1st and reverse brake (B3)
No engine braking (2nd: 2 position)
2nd coast brake (B1)
Poor acceleration (All position)
1. Torque converter clutch
2. O/D planetary gear
Poor acceleration (O/D)
1. O/D direct clutch (C0)
2. O/D planetary gear
Large shift shock or engine stalls when starting off or stopping
Torque converter clutch
Author:
Date:
690
DI–456
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI1KB–01
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft, which is rotated
by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear. After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the
ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
4–Pulse
4–Pulse
Vehicle Speed
Sensor
Combination
Meter
ECM
Transaxle
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Q00515 Q00514
A00223
DTC No.
P0500
DTC Detecting Condition
No vehicle speed sensor signal to ECM under conditions (a)
and (b)
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Park/neutral position switch is OFF
(b) Vehicle is being driven
Clutch or brake slips or gear is broken
Trouble Area
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
Automatic
A t
ti ttransaxle
l ((clutch,
l t h b
brake
k or gear etc.)
t )
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–333.
Author:
Date:
691
DI–457
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of speedometer.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the speedometer in the combination meter is normal.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
NG
Check speedometer circuit.
OK
2
Check for short in harness and connector between terminal SPD of ECM and
body ground.
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
SPD
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–73).
(b) Disconnect the connector from ECM.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal SPD of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
No continuity (1 M Ω or higher)
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
SPD
P23875
A02373
A02155
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
692
DI–458
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and
body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 ∼ 14 V
ON
Except California, w/ Engine
Immobilizer and / or TRAC:
SPD
(+)
(–)
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
(–)
(+)
SPD
BE6653
P23876
D01908
D02281
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between junction connector (J15) and ECM (See
page IN–31).
OK
4
Check for open in harness and connector between junction connector (J15) and
combination meter (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
693
DI–459
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Replace ECM.
OK
Check and repair the transaxle (clutch, brake
or gear etc.).
Author:
Date:
694
DI–460
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02K–02
DTC
P0750, P0755
Shift Solenoid A/B Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1/No.2)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor and direct clutch speed sensor to detect the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
trouble of the shift solenoid valves, valve body or automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
DTC No.
P0750
P0755
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
During normal driving, the gear required by the ECM does not
match the actual gear
(2 trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
Check the shift solenoid valve No.1 when DTC P0750 is output and check the shift solenoid valve No.2 when
DTC P0755 is output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2 operation.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the oil pan.
(b) Remove the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
CHECK:
(a) Applying 490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) of compressed air,
check that the solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) When battery positive voltage is supplied to the shift solenoid valve, check that the valve opens.
Q07781
NG
Replace the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
OK
Author:
Date:
695
DI–461
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check the valve body (See page DI–453 ).
NG
Repair or replace the valve body.
OK
Repair the transaxle.
Author:
Date:
696
DI–462
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02L–02
DTC
P0753, P0758
Shift Solenoid A/B Electrical Malfunction (Shift Solenoid Valve No.1/No.2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to O/D is performed in combination with ON and OFF of the shift solenoid valves No.1 and
No.2 controlled by ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
Fail Safe Function:
If either of the shift solenoid valve circuits develops an open or short, the ECM turns the other shift solenoid
ON and OFF to shift to the gear positions shown in the table below. The ECM also turns the shift solenoid
valve SL OFF at the same time. If both solenoids are malfunction, hydraulic control cannot be performed
electronically and must be done manually.
Manual shifting as shown in the following table must be done (In the case of a short circuit, the ECM stops
sending current to the short circuited solenoid).
SHIFT SOLENOID NO.1
MALFUNCTIONING
NORMAL
Position
D
2
L
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
ON
OFF
ON
Gear
1st
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
ON
X
ON
2nd
X
OFF
ON
3rd
X
OFF
OFF
O/D
X
Gear
SHIFT SOLENOID NO.2
MALFUNCTIONING
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
X
ON
Gear
BOTH SOLENOIDS MALFUNCTIONING
Gear when shift selector is
manually operated
1st
O/D
3rd
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
ON
3rd
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
OFF
O/D
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
3rd
ON
X
1st
O/D
3rd
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
ON
3rd
ON
OFF
1st
X
ON
ON
ON
2nd
X
ON
OFF
ON
3rd
X
ON
3rd
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
ON
OFF
1st
X
OFF
1st
ON
X
1st
1st
ON
ON
2nd
X
ON
2nd
ON
X
1st
1st
X: Malfunctions
Check the shift solenoid valve No.1 when DTC P0753 is output and check the shift solenoid valve No.2 when
DTC P0758 is output.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0753
P0758
The ECM checks for an open or short circuit in the shift solenoid valves No.1 and No.2 circuit when it changes.
The ECM records DTC P0753 or P0758 if condition (a) or (b) is
detected once, but it does not light up MIL.
After ECM detects condition (a) or (b) continuously 8 times or
more in a trip and the MIL light up.
(a) When the solenoid is energized, the solenoid resistance
is 8 Ω or less and is counted.
(b) When the solenoid is not energized, the solenoid resistance
is 100 kΩ or more and is counted.
Trouble Area
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2
ECM
Author:
Date:
697
DI–463
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transaxle
ECM
Shift Solenoid
Valve No.1
W
Shift Solenoid
Valve No.2
B
B+
3
E3
*2 *1
7 11
E11 E10 S1
V
B+
6
E3
L–B
J/C J26
A
A
L–B
*2 *1
8 17
S2
E11 E10
A
Cruise Control ECU
*1: Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
*2: California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
D01092
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Measure resistance between terminal S1 or S2 of ECM and body ground.
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
S1
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from ECM.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal S1 or S2 of ECM and
body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 11 ∼ 15 Ω
S2
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
S2
Q07642
D00833
S1
D01909
Author:
Date:
698
DI–464
DIAGNOSTICS
OK
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check and replace the ECM.
NG
2
Check harness and connector between ECM and automatic transaxle solenoid
connector.
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
S1
S2
S2
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the solenoid connector from the automatic transaxle.
CHECK:
Check the harness and connector between terminal S1 or S2
of ECM and terminal S1 or S2 of solenoid connector.
OK:
There is no open and no short circuit.
S1
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
S2
S1
S1
S2
Q07935
D00832
Q02283
D01910
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
699
DI–465
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the oil pan.
(c) Disconnect the solenoid connector.
(d) Remove the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
CHECK:
(a) Measure resistance between solenoid connector and
body ground.
(b) Connect the positive lead to terminal of solenoid connector, negative lead to solenoid body.
OK:
(a) Resistance: 11 ∼ 15 Ω
(b) The solenoid makes an operating noise.
D00048
NG
Replace the solenoid valve.
OK
Repair or replace the solenoid wire.
Author:
Date:
700
DI–466
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02M–02
DTC
P0770
Shift Solenoid E Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Controlled
Pressure
Line
Pressure
Controlled
Pressure Drain
Q04874
The ECM uses the signals from the throttle position sensor, air–
flow meter and crankshaft position sensor to monitor the engagement condition of the lock–up clutch.
Then the ECM compares the engagement condition of the
lock–up clutch with the lock–up schedule in the ECM memory
to detect mechanical trouble of the shift solenoid valve SL,
valve body, torque converter clutch or automatic transaxle
(clutch, brake or gear etc.).
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0770
Lock–up does not occur when driving in the lock–up range
(normal driving at 80 km/h [50 mph]), or lock–up remains ON
in the lock–up OFF range.
(2 trip detection logic)
When lock–up is ON, clutch or brake slips or gear is broken.
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or closed
Valve body blocked up or stuck
Lock–up clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check solenoid valve SL operation.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the oil pan.
(b) Remove the shift solenoid valve SL.
CHECK:
(a) Applying 490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) of compressed air,
check that the solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) When battery positive voltage is supplied to the shift solenoid valve, check that the solenoid valve opens.
Q08040
NG
Replace the solenoid valve SL.
OK
Author:
Date:
701
DI–467
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check valve body (See page DI–453).
NG
Repair or replace the valve body.
OK
Check the torque converter clutch (See page AX–21).
NG
Replace the torque converter clutch.
OK
Repair the transaxle.
Author:
Date:
702
DI–468
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02N–02
DTC
P0773
Shift Solenoid E Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The shift solenoid valve SL is turned ON and OFF by signals from the ECM to control the hydraulic pressure
acting on the lock–up relay valve, which then controls operation of the lock–up clutch.
Fail safe function
If the ECM detects a malfunction, it turns the shift solenoid valve SL OFF.
DTC No.
P0773
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Either (a) or (b) are detected for 1 time.
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Solenoid resistance is 8 Ω or less short circuit when solenoid is energized.
(b) Solenoid resistance is 100 kΩ or more open circuit when
solenoid is not energized.
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transaxle
ECM
Shift Solenoid
Valve SL
B+
Y
2
E3
*2 *1
9 27
SL
E11 E10
P–L
*1: Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
*2: California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
Author:
D01093
Date:
703
DI–469
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Measure resistance between terminal SL of ECM and body ground.
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from ECM.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal SL of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
Resistance: 8 ∼ 100,000 Ω
SL
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
SL
Q07648
D00839
D01911
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
NG
Author:
Date:
704
DI–470
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check harness and connector between ECM and automatic transaxle solenoid
connector (See page IN–31).
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
SL
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the solenoid connector from the transaxle.
CHECK:
Check the harness and connector between terminal SL of ECM
and terminal SL of solenoid connector.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
SL
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
SL
SL
Q07938
D00840
D01912
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
705
DI–471
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check shift solenoid valve SL.
D00049
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the oil pan.
(c) Disconnect the shift solenoid valve SL connector.
(d) Remove the shift solenoid valve SL.
CHECK:
(a) Measure resistance between terminal SL of shift solenoid
valve and solenoid body.
(b) Connect positive lead to terminal of solenoid connector, negative lead to solenoid body.
OK:
(a) Resistance: 11 ∼ 15 Ω
(b) The shift solenoid valve SL makes operation
noise.
NG
Replace the shift solenoid valve SL.
OK
Check and replace or repair the solenoid
wire.
Author:
Date:
706
DI–472
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02O–02
DTC
P1520
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The purpose of this circuit is to prevent the engine from stalling, while driving in lock–up condition, when
brakes are suddenly applied.
When the brake pedal is operated, this switch sends a signals to ECM. Then the ECM cancels operation
of the lock–up clutch while braking is in progress.
DTC No.
P1520
DTC Detecting Condition
No stop light switch signal to ECM during driving.
(2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Open or short in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–363.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
See page DI–363.
Author:
Date:
707
DI–473
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02P–02
DTC
P1705
NC2 Revolution Sensor Circuit Malfunction
(Direct Clutch Speed Sensor)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the rotation speed of the direct clutch drum.
By comparing the direct clutch speed signal and the vehicle
speed sensor signal, the ECM detects the shift timing of the
gears and appropriately controls the engine torque and hydraulic pressure in response to various conditions, thus performing
smooth gear shifting.
NC2 Revolution Sensor
Q04869
DTC No.
P1705
DTC Detecting Condition
The ECM detects conditions (a), (b), (c), (d), (e) and (f) continuity for 4 sec or more.
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed : 32 km/h (20 mph) or more
(b) 3rd or 4th gear
(c) NC2 < 300 rpm
(d) Park/neutral position switch: OFF
(e) Solenoid valves and vehicle speed sensor are normal
(f) L position: OFF
Trouble Area
Open or short in direct clutch speed sensor circuit
Direct clutch speed sensor
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
R
*2 *1
14 9
NC2+
E11 E9
2 V3
Direct Clutch
Speed Sensor
4∼6V
1 V3
G
*2 *1
26 4
NC2–
E11 E9
*1: Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
*2: California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
Author:
D01094
Date:
708
DI–474
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check resistance between terminals NC2+ and NC2– of ECM.
1
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
NC2+
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from ECM.
CHECK:
Check resistance between terminals NC2+ and NC2– of ECM.
OK:
Resistance: 560 ∼ 680 Ω
NC2–
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
NC2+
NC2–
Q07936
D00834
D01913
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
NG
Author:
Date:
709
DI–475
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check No.2 vehicle speed sensor.
Magnet
PREPARATION:
Remove the Direct clutch speed sensor from transaxle.
CHECK:
(a) Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed
sensor.
(b) Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the speed
sensor when a magnet is put close to the front end of the
speed sensor then taken away quickly.
OK:
(a) Resistance: 560 ∼ 680 Ω
(b) Voltage is generated intermittently.
HINT:
The voltage generated is extremely low.
Q08218
NG
Replace the Direct clutch speed sensor.
OK
Check and repair the harness and connector
between ECM and Direct clutch speed sensor (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
710
DI–476
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02Q–02
DTC
P1765
Linear Solenoid for Accumulator Pressure Control
Circuit Malfunction (Shift Solenoid Valve SLN)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
High
Accumulator Control Pressure
The shift solenoid valve SLN controls the hydraulic pressure
acting on the accumulator control valve when gears are shifted
and performs smooth gear shifting.
The ECM determines optimum operating pressure according to
the signals from the throttle position sensor, vehicle speed sensor and direct clutch speed sensor and controls the volume of
current flow to the solenoid valve.
The amount of current to the solenoid is controlled by the (*)
duty ratio of ECM output signals, causing a momentary change
to the hydraulic pressure acting on the clutches during gear
shifting.
When the duty ratio is high, the hydraulic pressure acting on the
clutches is low.
0
Electric Current (A)
1
AT5608
(*) Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle.
For example, if A is the period of continuity in one cycle, and B is the period of non–continuity, then
D00060
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
After the engine is warmed up, the current flow to the shift
solenoid valve SLN for 1 sec or more under condition (a) or
(b):
(a) Engine speed: 500 rpm or more
(b) Park/neutral position switch: ON (P or N position)
P1765
Trouble Area
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SLN circuit
Shift solenoid valve SLN
ECM
Reference
Waveform between terminals SLN+
and SLN– when engine is idling.
Waveform between terminals SLN+
and SLN– when during shift change.
5 V/div.
5 V/div.
GND
GND
1 msec./div.
1 msec./div.
D00062
Author:
Date:
711
DI–477
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
W–L
1 E3
R
*2 *1
20 3
SLN+
E11 E10
Shift Solenoid
Valve SLN
L
4 E3
B–Y
*2 *1
19 2
SLN–
E11 E9
*1: Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
*2: California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
D01095
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check shift solenoid valve SLN.
2
2
1
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the shift solenoid valve SLN connector.
CHECK:
(a) Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of solenoid connector.
(b) Connect positive lead with an 8 ∼10 W bulb to terminal
1 of solenoid connector and negative lead to terminal
2, then check the movement of the valve.
OK:
(a) Resistance: 5.1 ∼ 5.5 Ω
(b)
1
When battery positive voltage is applied.
Valve move in direction in illustration.
(on the left)
When battery positive voltage is cut off.
Valve move in direction in illustration.
(on the right)
D00050
Author:
Date:
712
DI–478
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Reference
PREPARATION:
Connect positive lead of the variable power supply to terminal 1 of solenoid connector and negative lead to terminal 2.
CHECK:
(a) Check the movement of the valve when the voltage is
gradually increased.
(A current greater than 1A should not be supplied.)
(b) Check the movement of the valve when the voltage is cut
off.
OK:
(a) As the voltage is increased, the valve should move
direction.
slowly in the
direction.
(b) The valve should return in the
(+)
1 2
(–)
D00051
NG
Replace the shift solenoid valve SLN.
OK
2
Check harness and connector between battery and shift solenoid valve SLN,
shift solenoid valve SLN and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Author:
Date:
713
DI–479
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI1KC–01
DTC
P1780
Park/Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever position and sends signals to the ECM.
The ECM receives signals (NSW, R, 2 and L) from the park/neutral position switch. When the signal is not
sent to the ECM from the park/neutral position switch, the ECM judges that the shift lever is in D position.
DTC No.
P1780
DTC Detection Condition
When driving under conditions (a) and (b) for 30 seconds or
more, the park/neutral position switch is ON (N position).
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 70 km/h (44 mph) or more
(b) Engine speed: 1,500 ∼ 2,500 rpm
Trouble Area
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
Author:
Date:
714
DI–480
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC:
Instrument Panel J/B
Combination Meter
R
8
C8
2
11
C8
O
13
IJ1
L
6
C8
Y
16
IG3
ECM
5
1V
10
1H
R–B
L–W
E
10
2
E7
E
J/C J29
2L
R–L
A
L
Y
Park/Neutral Position Switch
4
5
LL
Y E
Y
P1
II2
2
C
P1
1
E7
Y
R–B
D
3
6
L–W
P1
II2
L–W
L–W (*1, *3)
O (*2, *4)
D
15
R
E7
D
C
C J27 A
J28
J27
J/C J29
8
RL P1
J/C
J24
3
R–B II3
R–B
A
6
P1
R–L
B+
J/C
5
P1
GR
R–B
B–W
B–W
B
J/C J26 B
B–W
11
II2
J/C J28
2
II2
R–L
F
J28
B
F
J28
14 NSW
E10
J/C J29
B
B
B–W
10 II2
R–L
1
1B
B–R
AM1
1
2
W
GR (*4)
B–O (*5)
B–R
B–R
1 F9
2
1K
F9 2
5
1B
5
1K
1 F4
4
2L
F6 1
B–G
FL
Main
1
2A
Battery
B
J7
C
J8
GR (*4)
B–O (*5)
4
1K
R
Starter
3
1J
Engine Room J/B No.2
3
2B
B
B
Fusible
Link Block
1
1J
B–W
7 AM2 ST2 8
I16
I16
AM2
GAUGE
W–R
W–R
ALT
Ignition Switch
2
4
1
I16
I16 B–Y 1K
AM1 IG1
MAIN
1
5
5
B–R
2D
Starter
2
9
2K
2
ST
Relay
11
2J
3
1
J/C J11
A
W–B
J/C
Left Kick IG
Panel
*1: w/ Engine Immobilizer System
*2: w/o Engine Immobilizer System
*3: TMC Made Ex. USA w/ TRAC
*4: TMMK Made, TMC Made USA w/ TRAC
D01897
Author:
Date:
715
DI–481
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC:
Combination Meter
R
8
C8
2
11
C8
O
13
IJ1
L
6
C8
Y
16
IG3
10
1H
R–B
ECM
5
1V
Y
L–W
Park/Neutral Position Switch
4
5
Y
LL
Y E
P1
II2
3
2
E8
E
E
J/C J29
2
C
P1
2L 3 L–W
P1
R–L
6
II2
L–W
D
3
R–B
II3
8
RL P1
J/C
J24
D
C
J27
R–B
A
6
P1
11
B B–W II2
5
B–W B
P1
R–L
2
II2
R–L
C
J27
R–B
A
J28
B+
J/C
B–W B
B–W
B
20 NSW
E8
B J/C J29
J/C J26
GR
L–W (*1, *3)
O (*2, *4)
2
R
E8
R–B
D
J/C J29
A
12
L
E8
Y
F
J28
J/C J28
F
J28
10 II2
R–L
B–R
AM1
1
2
2
1K
B–R
F9 2
5
1B
Ignition Switch
2
4
I16
I16
AM1 IG1
ALT
F6 1
Fusible
Link Block
Battery
AM2
C
J8
MAIN
1
F
J7
GR (*4)
B–O (*5)
4
1K
R
3
1J
Starter
Engine Room J/B No.2
3
2B
B
1
1J
B–W
1
2A
B
GAUGE
Instrument Panel J/B
7 AM2 ST2 8
I16
I16
4
2L
1
B–Y 1K
5
W–R
1K
W–R
1 F4
B–G
FL
Main
Instrument Panel J/B
W
GR (*4)
B–O (*5)
B–R
1 F9
1
1B
11
2J
5
3
5
B–R
2D
Starter
2
9
2K
2
ST
Relay
1
J/C J11
A
W–B
J/C
*1: w/ Engine Immobilizer System
*2: w/o Engine Immobilizer System
*3: TMC Made Ex. USA w/ TRAC
*4: TMMK Made, TMC Made USA w/ TRAC
Left Kick
Panel
IG
D01898
Author:
Date:
716
DI–482
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Read PNP, REVERSE, 2ND and LOW signals.
When using TOYOTA hand–held tester.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the DLC3 cover.
(b) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Shift lever into the P, R, N, 2 and L positions, and read the PNP,
REVERSE, 2ND and LOW signals on the TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
OK:
ON
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
NSW
L
2
L
NSW
BE3840
D00052
D00836
D01914
Signal
2
2ND OFF → ON
L
LOW OFF → ON
R
REVERSE OFF → ON
P, N
NSW OFF → ON
When not using TOYOTA hand–held tester.
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals NSW, 2, L and R of ECM
and body ground when the shift lever is shifted to the following
positions.
OK:
R
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
R
2
Shift position
Position
NSW–Body
ground
R–Body
ground
2–Body
ground
L–Body
ground
P, N
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
R
9 ∼ 14 V*
D
9 ∼ 14 V
0V
2
9 ∼ 14 V
0V
L
9 ∼ 14 V
0V
9 ∼ 14 V*
9 ∼ 14 V
0V
0V
9 ∼ 14 V
HINT:
*: The voltage will drop slightly due to lighting up of the back up
light.
Author:
Date:
717
DI–483
DIAGNOSTICS
OK
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page DI–453).
NG
2
Check park/neutral position switch.
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the park/neutral position switch.
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal shown below when the
shift lever is moved to each position.
Shift Position
Q07657
Terminal No. to continuity
P
2–7
5–6
R
2–8
–
N
2–9
5–6
D
2 – 10
–
2
2–3
–
L
2–4
–
OK:
There is continuity.
NG
Replace the park/neutral position switch.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between battery and park/neutral position switch,
park/neutral position switch and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace the harness and connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Author:
Date:
718
DI–484
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI02S–02
O/D Cancel Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
While driving uphill with cruise control activated, in order to minimize gear shifting and provide smooth cruising overdrive may be prohibited temporarily under some condition.
The cruise control ECU sends O/D cut signals to the ECM as necessary and the ECM cancels overdrive
shifting until these signals are discontinued.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Cruise Control ECU
B+
14
OD C15
Y–B
*2 *1
24
7 OD1
E10 E7
*1: Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
*2: California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
Author:
D01899
Date:
719
DI–485
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal OD1 of ECM and body ground.
ON
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
(–)
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal OD1 of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 ∼ 14 V
OD1
(+)
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
(–)
BE3840
Q07659
D00053
D00835
(+)
OD1
D01915
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page DI–453).
NG
Author:
Date:
720
DI–486
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Check voltage between terminal OD of cruise control ECU harness side connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the cruise control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal OD of cruise control ECU
harness side connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 ∼ 14 V
ON
O/D
(–)
(+)
AB0119
N19917
I00742
OK
Check and replace the cruise control ECU.
NG
3
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and ECM.
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Author:
Date:
721
DI–487
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
DI1KD–01
O/D Main Switch & O/D OFF Indictor Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The O/D main switch contacts go open when the switch is pushed in and go closed when it is pushed out.
In O/D main switch at OFF position, the O/D OFF indicator light lights up, and the ECM prohibits shifting overdrive.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
R–L
O/D Indicator
Light
J/C J6
7
12
G–O
G–O
C10
C8
C
C
C
D
J/C J4
G–O
D
Instrument Panel J/B
1
2
GAUGE
1D
1K
R–L
Instrument Panel J/B
1
2
AM1
1B
1K
1 2
2
O2
*2 *1
10 6
G–O
OD2
E8 E7
11
IG3
O/D Main
Switch
4
O2
B–Y
W
Ignition Switch
4
2
I16
I16
AM1 IG1
B–R
B–R 1
F9
B+
Fusible Link Block
W–B
1
F4
B–G
ALT
B–R
2
F9
FL Main
A
J/C J5
A
W–B
Battery
IF
Left Kick Panel
*1: Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
*2: California, w/ Engine Immobilizer and / or TRAC
D01900
Author:
Date:
722
DI–488
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
O/D OFF indicator light does not light up
1
Check O/D main switch.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the O/D main switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals 2 and 4 of O/D main switch
connector.
OK:
2
4
Q07595
NG
O/D main switch
Resistance
ON
∞ Ω (open)
OFF
0 Ω (continuity)
Replace the O/D main switch.
OK
2
Check and replace the combination meter (See page BE–2).
Replace the combination meter.
NG
OK
3
Check OVRDRIVE CUT SW2 signal.
When using TOYOTA hand–held tester
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the OVRDRIVE CUT SW2 signal on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
OK:
O/D main switch condition
OVRDRIVE CUT SW2 signal
Pushed in
OFF
Pushed out
ON
Author:
Date:
723
DI–489
DIAGNOSTICS
ON
Except California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
(–)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
When not using TOYOTA hand–held tester
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check voltage between terminal OD2 of ECM and body ground.
OK:
OD2
O/D main switch
Voltage
OFF
Below 1 V
ON
10 ∼ 14 V
(+)
California, w/ Engine Immobilizer
and / or TRAC:
(–)
(+)
OD2
BE3840
Q07662
D00837
D01916
NG
Check and replace the ECM.
NG
4
Check harness and connector between O/D OFF indicator light and ECM
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Author:
Date:
724
DI–490
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
O/D OFF indicator light remains on
1
Check O/D main switch.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the O/D main switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals 2 and 4 of O/D main switch
connector.
OK:
2
4
Q07595
NG
O/D main switch
Resistance
ON
∞ Ω (open)
OFF
0 Ω (continuity)
Replace the O/D main switch.
OK
2
Check harness and connector between O/D OFF indicator light and O/D main
switch, O/D OFF indicator light and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Author:
Date:
725
DI–491
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03A–02
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manual,
with the page number in the bottom portion. See
the pages for detailed explanations.
1
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–492
2
Check and Clear DTC (Precheck)
P. DI–493
Symptom
does not occur
3
Problem Symptom Confirmation
4
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
7
Problem Symptoms Table
P. DI–501
Symptom
occurs
5
Normal code
DTC Check
P. DI–493
Malfunction code
6
8
DTC Chart
P. DI–497
Circuit Inspection
9
Sensor Check
Check for Fluid Leakage
P. DI–536
P. DI–502 ∼ DI–534
Identification of Problem
10
11
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step 2, 5, 8, 9, 11: Diagnostic steps permitting the use of the
TOYOTA hand–held tester or TOYOTA
break–out–box.
Author:
Date:
726
DI–492
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03B–02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ABS Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem First Occurred
/
Frequency Problem Occurs
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
times a day)
ABS does not operate.
Symptoms
ABS does not operate efficiently.
ABS Warning Light
Abnormal
Remains ON
Does not Light Up
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
DTC Check
Author:
Date:
727
DI–493
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03C–03
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
F00047
Short Pin
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Check the indicator.
When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 3 seconds.
HINT:
If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to
troubleshooting for the ABS warning light circuit
(See page DI–529).
(b) Check the DTC.
(1) Disconnect the short pin from DLC1.
DLC1
F00006
DLC2
Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(4) Read the DTC from the ABS warning light on the
combination meter.
(2)
DLC1
E1
Tc
Tc
S−17−1
HINT:
E1
Iei−23−1−A
F00041
If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit or ABS
warning light circuit (See page DI–532 or DI–529).
As an example, the blinking patterns for normal code and
codes 11 and 21 are shown on the left.
(5) Codes are explained in the code table on page
DI–497.
(6) After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc
and E1, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time the lowest numbered DTC will be displayed 1st.
Normal Code
2 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 11 and 21
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
4 sec.
0.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 11
Code 21
R01346
Author:
Date:
728
DI–494
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
(c)
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester, check the DTC.
(1) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC2.
(2) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(d)
Clear the DTC.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1 and remove the short pin from DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Clear the DTC stored in ECU by depressing the
brake pedal 8 or more times within 5 seconds.
DLC2
H07517
BR3890
(4)
Check that the warning light shows the normal
code.
(5) Remove the SST from the terminals of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(6) Connect the short pin to DLC1.
Short Pin
DLC1
F00006
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
ECU
TOYOTA
Break–out–box
N09348
(e)
Using TOYOTA break–out–box and TOYOTA hand–held
tester, measure the ECU terminal values.
(1) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester and
TOYOTA break–out–box to the vehicle.
(2) Read the ECU input/output values by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” function. This records the measured values and is effective in the diagnosis of
intermittent problems.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester/TOYOTA break–
out–box operator’s manual for further details.
Author:
Date:
729
DI–495
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
DLC1
E1
–
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
Check the speed sensor signal.
(1) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(3) Start the engine.
Tc
Ts
F02201
(4)
0.13 sec.
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR3904
Check that the ABS warning light blinks.
HINT:
If the ABS warning light does not blink, inspect the ABS warning
light circuit (See page DI–529).
(5) Drive vehicle straight forward.
HINT:
Drive vehicle faster than 45 km/h (28 mph) for several seconds.
(6) Stop the vehicle.
(7) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(8) Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
HINT:
See the list of DTC shown on the next page.
If every sensor is normal, a normal code is output (A cycle
of 0.25 sec. ON and 0.25 sec. OFF is repeated).
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed 1st.
Malfunction Code (Example Code 72, 76)
7
2
7
6
ON
OFF
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
2.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
Repeat
BR3893
(9)
After doing the check, disconnect the SST from terminals Ts and E1, Tc and E1 of DLC1, and turn ignition switch OFF.
SST 09843 – 18020
Author:
Date:
730
DI–496
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
(b)
DLC2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester, check the DTC.
(1) Do step 1. ∼ 6. on the previous page.
(2) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC2.
(3) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
H07517
DTC of speed sensor check function:
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
71
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Right front speed sensor rotor
72
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Left front speed sensor rotor
73
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Right rear speed sensor rotor
74
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Left rear speed sensor rotor
75
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor rotor
76
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
Left front speed sensor rotor
77
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
Right rear speed sensor rotor
78
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor rotor
Author:
Date:
731
DI–497
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03D–03
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Using SST 09843 –18020, connect the terminals Tc and E1, and remove the short pin.
If any abnormality is not found when inspection parts, inspect the ECU.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for the code. For details
of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ”See page” for respective ”DTC No.” in the DTC
chart.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
11
(DI–502)
Open circuit in ABS solenoid relay circuit
12
(DI–502)
Short circuit in ABS solenoid relay circuit
13
(DI–507)
Open circuit in ABS motor relay circuit
14
(DI–507)
Short circuit in ABS motor relay circuit
21
(DI–511)
Open or short circuit in 2–position solenoid circuit for right front
wheel
ABS actuator
SFRR or SFRH circuit
22
(DI–511)
Open or short circuit in 2–position solenoid circuit for left front
wheel
ABS actuator
SFLR or SFLH circuit
23
(DI–511)
Open or short circuit in 2–position solenoid circuit for right rear
wheel
ABS actuator
SRRR or SRRH circuit
24
(DI–511)
Open or short circuit in 2–position solenoid circuit for left rear
wheel
ABS actuator
SRLR or SRLH circuit
31
(DI–514)
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
32
(DI–514)
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
33
(DI–514)
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
ABS solenoid relay
ABS solenoid relay circuit
ABS motor relay
ABS motor relay circuit
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each
E h speed
d sensor circuit
i it
Speed sensor rotor
34
(DI–514)
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
33, 34
(DI–519)
Rear speed sensor rotor faulty
Rear axle hub
Right rear, left rear speed sensor
Rear speed sensor circuit
41
(DI–520)
Power source voltage down
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
49
(DI–523)
Open circuit in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
51
(DI–525)
Pump motor is locked
ABS pump motor
Malfunction in ECU
ECU
Battery
Always ON
(DI–527)
Author:
Date:
732
DI–498
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03E–03
PARTS LOCATION
Sensor Rotor
ABS Warning Light
ABS ECU
DLC 1
Front Speed Sensor
ABS Actuator
DLC 2
ABS Solenoid
Relay
ABS Motor Relay
Rear Speed Sensor
Front Speed
Sensor
Stop Light Switch
Sensor Rotor
F01172
Author:
Date:
733
DI–499
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI1JL–02
TERMINALS OF ECU
A18
A19
3
2
1
13 12 11 10 9 8 7
12 11 10 9
8
7
26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14
6
5
4
6 5 4 3
2 1
F07155
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
IG1 (A19 – 13) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
B–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
10 – 14
R+ (A19 – 26) – SR (A18 – 7)
GR–R ↔ GR
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
9 – 14
R+ (A19 – 26) – MR (A18 – 1)
GR–R ↔ GR–L
SFRR (A19 – 1) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
W–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFRH (A19 – 2) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
R–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFLR (A18 – 6) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
W–L ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFLH (A18 – 5) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
L–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRRR (A18 – 12) – GND (A19
– 12, 25)
R–G ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRRH (A18 – 11) – GND (A19
– 12, 25)
W–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRLR (A19 – 14) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
LG–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRLH (A19 – 15) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
G–Y ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
WA (A19 – 11) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
G B ↔ W–B
G–B
W B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light ON
Below 2.0
IG switch ON
Below 1.0
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
Stop light switch OFF
Below 1.5
Stop light switch ON
8 – 14
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
STP (A19 – 5) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
G W ↔ W–B
G–W
W B
D/G (A19 – 24) – GND (A19 –
12, 25)
R–L ↔ W–B
Tc (A19 – 8) – GND (A19 – 12,
25)
LG–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
8 – 14
Ts (A19 – 21) – GND (A19 – 12,
25)
R–Y ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
8 – 14
FR+ (A18 – 3) – FR– (A18 – 9)
W↔B
IG switch ON, slowly turn right front wheel
AC generation
FL+ (A18 – 8) – FL– (A18 – 2)
R↔G
IG switch ON, slowly turn left front wheel
AC generation
RR+ (A19 – 10) – RR– (A19 –
23)
W↔B
IG switch ON, slowly turn right rear wheel
AC generation
Author:
Date:
734
DI–500
DIAGNOSTICS
RL+ (A19 – 22) – RL– (A19 – 9)
R↔G
MT (A18 – 10) – GND (A18 –
12, 25)
R–W ↔ W–B
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
IG switch ON, slowly turn left rear wheel
AC generation
IG switch ON
Below 1.5
Author:
Date:
735
DI–501
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03G–04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal code is displayed during the DTC check but the problem still occurs, check the circuits for each
problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant troubleshooting page.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
ABS does not operate
Only when 1. to 4. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
13.Check the DTC reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
14.IG power source circuit.
15.Speed sensor circuit.
16.Check the ABS actuator with a checker.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
(See page DI–536).
ABS does not operate efficiently
Only when 1. το 4. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the DTC reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
2. Speed sensor circuit
3. Stop light switch circuit
4. Check the ABS actuator with a checker.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
(See page DI–536).
ABS warning light abnormal
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. ABS ECU
DI–529
DI–527
DTC check cannot be done
Only when 1. and 2. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. Tc terminal circuit
DI–529
DI–532
Speed sensor signal check cannot be done
1. Ts terminal circuit
2. ABS ECU
DI–534
DI–527
Author:
Date:
DI–493
DI–520
DI–514
BR–50
DI–493
DI–514
DI–523
BR–50
736
DI–502
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03H–03
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
11, 12
ABS Solenoid Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This relay supplies power to each ABS solenoid. After the ignition switch is turned ON, if the initial check is
OK, the relay goes on.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
11
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.2 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
when the solenoid relay is ON.*1
2. With solenoid relay ON driving, when IG1 terminal of
ABS ECU is less than 9.5 V.*1
12
Immediately after IG switch has been turned ON, when the
solenoid relay is OFF.*2
Trouble Area
ABS solenoid relay
ABS solenoid relay circuit
ECU
*1 Solenoid relay contact OFF condition:
All of solenoid terminal voltage is half of IG1 terminal voltage or less than.
*2 Solenoid relay contact ON condition:
All of solenoid terminal voltage is half of IG 1 terminal voltage or more.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the ABS solenoid relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and
prohibits ABS control.
Author:
Date:
737
DI–503
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
IK1
GR–R
ABS Solenoid Relay
3
6
4
ABS ECU
26
A19 R+
GR–R
Engine Room
R/B No.3
GR
3
7
A18 SR
DLC1
ABS
Actuator
5
3
3
1
3
2
3
ABS
1
2
3
W–L
B–G
Fusible Link Block
1
F4
1
F5
ALT
B–G
FL Main
W–B
4
A4
1
A5
R–B
11
IK2
R–B
2
A19 SFRH
5
A5
W–R
12
IK2
W–R
1
A19 SFRR
3
A5
L–B
5
A18 SFLH
7
A5
W–L
6
A18 SFLR
4
A5
W–R
11
A18 SRRH
8
A5
R–G
12
A18 SRRR
2
A5
G–Y
13
IK2
G–Y
15
A19 SRLH
6
A5
LG–B
5
IK2
LG–B
14
A19 SRLR
Battery
EA
F07147
Author:
Date:
738
DI–504
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of Engine Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS solenoid relay).
(+)
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS solenoid relay from Engine Room R/B No. 3.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of Engine
Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS solenoid relay).
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
(–)
Engine Room
R/B No. 3
123
45 6
F00048
NG
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
2
Check continuity between terminal 3 of ABS solenoid relay and terminal SRLR,
SRLH, SRRR, SRRH, SFLR, SFLH, SFRR or SFRH of ABS ECU.
ABS
Solenoid
Relay
3
A4
4
A5
ABS
Actuator
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal 3 of Engine Room R/B No.3
(for ABS solenoid relay) and terminal SRLR, SRLH, SRRR,
SRRH, SFLR, SRLH, SFRR or SFRH of ABS ECU.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
Resistance of each solenoid coil
SRLR, SRRR, SFLR, SFRR: 4.3 Ω
SRLH, SRRH, SFLH, SFRH: 8.8 Ω
1234
5678
4321
8765
A18
ECU
SFRH
SFRR
SFLH
SFLR
SRLR
SRLH
SRRH
SRRR
F07153
NG
Repair or replace harness or ABS actuator.
OK
Author:
Date:
739
DI–505
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check ABS solenoid relay.
3
2
6
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS solenoid relay.
OK:
1
5
4
Terminals 4 and 6
Continuity (Reference value 80 Ω)
Terminals 2 and 3
Continuity
Terminals 1 and 3
Open
Open
3 2 1
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 4 and 6.
(b) Check continuity between each terminal of ABS solenoid
relay.
OK:
Continuity
Continuity
6 5 4
Terminals 2 and 3
Open
Terminals 1 and 3
Continuity
Continuity
3 2
1
Open
(–)
(+)
6
5 4
F00042
NG
Replace ABS solenoid relay.
OK
Author:
Date:
740
DI–506
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS solenoid relay and ABS ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
Author:
Date:
741
DI–507
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03I–03
DTC
13, 14
ABS Motor Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS motor relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor. While the ABS is activated, the ECU switches
the ABS motor relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
13
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.2 sec. or more:
1. ABS ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V to 18.5 V, and
when motor relay is ON in the midst of initial check or in
operation of ABS control.*1
2. Motor relay is ON driving in the midst of initial check or
in operation of ABS control, ABS ECU terminal IG1 voltage becomes 9.5 V or less.*2
14
Condition below continues for 4 sec. or more:
When the motor relay is OFF, there is open circuit in MT
terminal of ABS ECU.
Trouble Area
ABS motor relay
ABS motor relay circuit
ECU
*1 Relay contact OFF condition: MT terminal voltage is below 3.6 V.
*2 Relay contact ON condition: MT terminal voltage is 3.6 V or above.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the ABS motor relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
Author:
Date:
742
DI–508
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS ECU
ABS Motor
Relay
B–G
F5 1
ABS
3
3
1
3
2
4
3
GR–R
1
IK1
GR–R
GR–L
3
26
A19 R+
1
A18 MR
Fusible
Link
Block
ALT
Engine Room R/B No.3
F4 1
ABS Actuator
3
A4
B–G
R–W
10
A18 MT
2
A4
W–R
FL
Main
1
A4
W–B
Battery
EA
F07146
Author:
Date:
743
DI–509
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal 1 of Engine Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS motor
relay) and body ground.
(–)
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS motor relay from Engine Room R/B No. 3.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of Engine Room R/B No.
3 (for ABS motor relay) and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
(+)
1
Engine Room
R/B No. 3
2
3 4
F00049
NG
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
2
Check continuity between terminal 2 of ABS motor relay and terminal MT of ABS
ECU.
2
ABS
Motor
Relay
2
A4
2
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal 2 of Engine Room R/B No.3
(for ABS motor relay) and terminal MT of ABS ECU.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
There is a resistance of 4 ∼ 6 Ω between terminals A4 – 2 and
A4 – 3 of ABS actuator.
A4
ABS
Actuator
3
3
A18
ECU
MT
F07154
NG
Repair or replace harness or ABS actuator.
OK
Author:
Date:
744
DI–510
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check ABS motor relay.
2
1
4
3
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS motor relay.
OK:
Terminals 3 and 4
Continuity (Reference value 62 Ω)
Terminals 1 and 2
Open
Open
2
Continuity
1
4
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 3 and 4.
(b) Check continuity between terminals of ABS motor relay.
3
Continuity
2
OK:
1
Terminals 1 and 2
(–)
4
Continuity
3
(+)
F00044
NG
Replace ABS motor relay.
OK
4
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS motor
relay and ABS ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
Author:
Date:
745
DI–511
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03J–03
DTC
21, 22, 23, 24
ABS Actuator Solenoid Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on the wheel
cylinders thus controlling the braking force.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
21
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.05 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, there
is open or short circuit in actuator solenoid SFRR or
SFRH.
2. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
while ABS is control in operation.*1
ABS actuator
SFRR or SFRH circuit
22
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.05 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, there
is open or short circuit in actuator solenoid SFLR or
SFLH.
2. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
while ABS is control in operation.*1
ABS actuator
SFLR or SFLH circuit
23
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.05 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, there
is open or short circuit in actuator solenoid SRRR or
SRRH.
2. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
while ABS is control in operation.*1
ABS actuator
SRRR or SRRH circuit
24
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.05 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, there
is open or short circuit in actuator solenoid SRLR or
SRLH.
2. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
while ABS is control in operation.*1
ABS actuator
SRLR or SRLH circuit
*1 Solenoid relay contact ON condition:
All of solenoid terminal voltage is half of IG1 terminal voltage or less than.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the actuator solenoid circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
Author:
Date:
746
DI–512
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
IK1
GR–R
ABS Solenoid Relay
3
6
4
ABS ECU
26
A19 R+
GR–R
Engine Room
R/B No.3
GR
3
7
A18 SR
DLC1
ABS
Actuator
5
3
3
1
3
2
3
ABS
1
2
3
W–L
B–G
Fusible Link Block
1
F4
1
F5
ALT
B–G
FL Main
W–B
4
A4
1
A5
R–B
11
IK2
R–B
2
A19 SFRH
5
A5
W–R
12
IK2
W–R
1
A19 SFRR
3
A5
L–B
5
A18 SFLH
7
A5
W–L
6
A18 SFLR
4
A5
W–R
11
A18 SRRH
8
A5
R–G
12
A18 SRRR
2
A5
G–Y
13
IK2
G–Y
15
A19 SRLH
6
A5
LG–B
5
IK2
LG–B
14
A19 SRLR
Battery
EA
F07147
Author:
Date:
747
DI–513
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
4
3
8
7
A4
2
1
A5
6
5
4
W00714
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS actuator.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals A4 – 4 and A5 – 1, 2, 3, 4,
5, 6, 7, 8 of ABS actuator connector.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
Resistance of each solenoid coil is 1.2 Ω.
NG
Replace ABS actuator.
OK
2
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and actuator (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
Author:
Date:
748
DI–514
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI1JM–02
DTC
Speed Sensor Circuit
31, 32, 33, 34
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Rotor
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to control
the ABS system. The front and rear rotors each have 48 serrations.
When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor generates an AC voltage.
Since the frequency of this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU
to detect the speed of each wheel.
Speed Sensor
S Magnet
N
Coil
To ECU
Low Speed
High Speed
+V
BR3583
BR3582
–V
F00010
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
31, 32, 33, 34
Detection of any of conditions from 1. through 4.:
1. Vehicle speed is at 10 km/h (6 mph) or more and the
speed sensor signal circuit is open or short circuit continues for 15 sec. or more.
2. Momentary interruption of the speed sensor signal occurs 7 times or more.
3. Vehicle speed is at 20 km/h (12mph) or more and interference on the speed sensor signal continues for 5 sec.
or more.
4. Open circuit condition of the speed sensor signal circuit
continues for 0.5 sec. or more.
Trouble Area
Right front, left front, right rear, left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Speed sensor rotor
HINT:
DTC
DTC
DTC
DTC
No.
No.
No.
No.
31 is for the right front speed sensor.
32 is for the left front speed sensor.
33 is for the right rear speed sensor.
34 is for the left rear speed sensor.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits
ABS control.
Author:
Date:
749
DI–515
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS ECU
W
3
A18 FR+
B
9
A18 FR–
2
Right Front
Speed Sensor
1
R
1
IK2
R
8
A18 FL+
G
6
IK2
G
2
A18 FL–
W
2
IL1
W
10
A19 RR+
B
1
IL1
B
23
A19 RR–
R
3
ID1
R
22
A19 RL+
G
9
ID1
G
9
A19 RL–
2
Left Front
Speed Sensor
1
1
Right Rear
Speed Sensor
2
1
Left Rear
Speed Sensor
2
F00116
Author:
Date:
750
DI–516
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check speed sensor.
1
2
R14205
1 2
R14213
Front:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the front fender liner.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector.
OK:
Resistance: 0.6 – 2.5 kΩ
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
Rear:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the seat cushion and side seatback.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector.
OK:
Resistance: 1.2 – 2.3 kΩ
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
NG
Replace speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–493).
OK
Author:
Date:
751
DI–517
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between each speed
sensor and ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check speed sensor installation.
CHECK:
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there is
no clearance between the sensor and steering
knuckle or rear axle carrier.
OK
NG
BR3795
NG
Replace speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–493).
OK
4
Check speed sensor and sensor rotor serrations.
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
2 m/s / Division
1 V / Division
REFERENCE: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ABS ECU.
(b) Connect the oscilloscope to the terminals FR+, FL+, RR+
or RL+ and GND of the ABS ECU.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle with about 30 km/h (19 mph), and check the
signal waveform.
W04200
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
Author:
Date:
752
DI–518
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check sensor rotor and sensor tip.
R00948
R00947
Front:
PREPARATION:
Remove the front drive shaft (See page SA–17 or SA–26).
CHECK:
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches or missing teeth or foreign objects.
PREPARATION:
Remove the front speed sensor (See page BR–68).
CHECK:
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign objects on the sensor tip.
Rear:
PREPARATION:
Remove the axle hub (See page SA–52).
CHECK:
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches or missing teeth or foreign objects.
PREPARATION:
Remove the rear speed sensor (See page BR–71).
CHECK:
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign objects on the sensor tip.
NG
Replace sensor rotor or speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–493).
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
753
DI–519
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03L–03
DTC
33, 34
Rear Speed Sensor Rotor Faulty
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
33, 34
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The condition that the both rear side wheels’ speed is
lower than the front wheels’ speed at 20 km/h (12 mph) or
more for 20 sec. or more when the IG switch turns ON
and OFF , which is repeated in a sequence more than 8
times.
Rear axle hub
Right rear, left rear speed sensor
Rear speed sensor circuit
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check rear axle hub (See page SA–9).
NG
Replace rear axle hub.
OK
2
Check rear speed sensor (See page DI–514).
NG
Replace rear speed sensor.
OK
3
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between rear speed
sensor and ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness and connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
754
DI–520
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03M–03
DTC
41
IG Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the ECU, hence the actuators.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
41
Condition 1. or 2. is detected:
1. Vehicle speed is at 3 km/h (1.9 mph) or more and ECU
terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V or less , which continues
for 10 sec. or more.
2. When IG1 terminal voltage is less than 9.5 V, there is
open circuit in the motor relay or in the solenoid relay, or
the solenoid circuit malfunction.
Trouble Area
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits
ABS control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Ignition
Switch
B–Y
2
AM1 IG1
4
1
1K
9
1J
ABS ECU
J/C
J12
Instrument Panel J/B
B–R
B–R
C
ECU–IG
C
13
A19 IG1
W
2
1K
Instrument Panel J/B
1
1B
AM1
1
F4
B–G
FL Block
B–R
1
F9
W–B
12
A19 GND1
W–B
25
A19 GND2
ALT
A
FL MAIN
Battery
J11
Junction
Connector
IG Instrument
Panel Brace LH
F07156
Author:
Date:
755
DI–521
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ECU–IG fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove ECU–IG fuse from Instrument Panel J/B.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
OK:
Continuity
ECU–IG
Instrument
Panel J/B
NG
Check for short circuit in all the harness and
components connected to ECU–IG fuse (See attached wiring diagram).
NG
Check and repair the charging system
5S–FE engine: (See page CH–1)
1MZ–FE engIne: (See page CH–1).
F00073
OK
2
Check battery positive voltage.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
OK
Author:
Date:
756
DI–522
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS ECU with connectors still connected.
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS
ECU connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
(–)
(+)
IG1
GND
GND
F07151
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
4
Check continuity between terminals GND of ABS ECU connector and body
ground.
LOCK
F07152
GND (+)
(–)
GND
F07216
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from the ABS ECU.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal GND of ABS ECU connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 Ω or less
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU and ECU–IG fuse (See page
IN–31).
Author:
Date:
757
DI–523
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03N–03
DTC
49
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
49
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
ABS ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V to 18.5 V and ABS
is in non–operation, the open circuit of the stop light switch
circuit continues for 0.3 sec. or more.
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS ECU
J/C
G–W
Instrument
Panel J/B
Stop Light
1R 5
Switch
4
2
G–W
1R
1S
2
1
W
J27
A
J28
C
7
1
F4
STOP
FL Block
1
4
1B
1
F9
G–W
G–W
R
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1C
5
A19 STP
G–R 2
Light Failure
Sensor
G–R
G–R
2 R11
B–R
ALT
B–G
MAIN
2 R9
H10 2
High
Right
Mounted
Stop
Stop
Light
5 R11
H10 1
5 R9
Light
W–B
W–B A
W–B
W–B
J/C
W–B
A
J40
W–B
Battery
Left
Stop
Light
BL Under the BP Back Panel
Left Center
Center
Pillar
F00124
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of stop light.
CHECK:
Check that stop light lights up when brake pedal is depressed and turns off when brake pedal is released.
NG
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–37).
OK
Author:
Date:
758
DI–524
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check voltage between terminal STP of ABS ECU and body ground.
STP
(+)
(–)
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS ECU with connectors still connected.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal STP of ABS ECU and body
ground when brake pedal is depressed.
OK:
Voltage: 8 – 14 V
F07150
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
3
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU and stop
light switch (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–501).
Author:
Date:
759
DI–525
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI4KW–01
DTC
51
ABS Pump Motor Lock
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
51
Trouble Area
ABS pump motor
ABS actuator pump motor is not operating normally.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the ABS pump motor, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits
ABS control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS ECU
ABS Motor
Relay
B–G
F5 1
ABS
3
3
1
3
2
4
3
GR–R
1
IK1
GR–R
GR–L
3
26
A19 R+
1
A18 MR
Fusible
Link
Block
ALT
Engine Room R/B No.3
F4 1
ABS Actuator
3
A4
B–G
R–W
10
A18 MT
2
A4
W–R
FL
Main
1
A4
W–B
Battery
EA
F07146
Author:
Date:
760
DI–526
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of ABS & TRAC pump motor.
A4
1
2
(–)
(+)
F03291
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the ABS actuator connector.
CHECK:
Connect positive lead to terminal A4–2 and negative lead
to terminal A4 – 1 of the ABS actuator connector, check that the
pump motor is operates.
OK:
The running sound of the pump motor should be
heard.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS motor relay, ABS actuator and
ABS ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Replace ABS actuator.
Author:
Date:
761
DI–527
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03P–04
DTC
Always ON
ABS ECU Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
Always ON
DTC Detecting Condition
ABS ECU internal malfunction is detected.
Trouble Area
ECU
Battery
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits
ABS control.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Is DTC output?
Check DTC on page DI–493.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
YES
Check ABS solenoid relay. Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS solenoid relay and DLC1 (See page IN–31).
YES
Check for open or short circuit in harness and
connector between ECU–IG fuse and ABS ECU
(See page IN–31).
NO
2
Is normal code displayed?
NO
3
Is ABS warning light go off?
NO
Author:
Date:
762
DI–528
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check battery positive voltage.
CHECK:
Check the battery positive voltage.
OK:
10 – 14 V
NG
Check and repair the charging system
5S–FE engine: (See page CH–1)
1MZ–FE engine: (See page CH–1).
OK
5
Check ABS warning light.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the connector from the ABS ECU.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check the ABS warning light goes off.
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS warning light, DLC1, DLC2, and
ABS ECU (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
763
DI–529
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03Q–03
ABS Warning Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects trouble, it lights the ABS warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS control. At
this time, the ECU records a DTC in memory.
After removing the short pin of the DLC1, connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or DLC2 to make the
ABS warning light blink and output the DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B No. 3
Instrument Panel J/B
2
1D
ABS Solenoid Relay
1
Battery
6
2
4
5
GAUGE
R–L
3
D
ABS ECU
J/C
J4
3
3
R–L
8
IK2
R–L
D
R–L
3
3
4 II3
C10 7
ABS Warning
R–L
Light
23
C10 4
Short
DLC1
ABS ECU
Pin
R–L
22
12 IG3
G–B
3
W–L
4 A4
ABS
Actuator
W–B
ABS ECU
5 II3
EA
G–B
G–B
C
C
J/C
J29
G–B 11
A19 WA
C
F07217
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Troubleshooting in accordance with the chart below for each trouble symptom.
ABS warning light does not light up
Go to step 1
ABS warning light remains on
Go to step 3
1
Check ABS warning light.
See combination meter troubleshooting on page BE–2.
NG
Repair bulb or combination meter assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
764
DI–530
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check ABS solenoid relay.
3
2
1
6
5
4
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS solenoid relay from Engine Room R/B No. 3.
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS solenoid relay.
OK:
Open
3 2 1
Terminals 4 and 6
Continuity (Reference value 80 Ω)
Terminals 2 and 3
Continuity
Terminals 1 and 3
Open
Continuity
Continuity
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 4 and 6.
(b) Check continuity between each terminal of ABS solenoid
relay.
OK:
65 4
Continuity
3 2 1
Terminals 2 and 3
Open
Terminals 1 and 3
Continuity
Open
(–)
6 5
4
CHECK:
Connect the test lead to terminal 5 and the lead to terminal
3. Check continuity between the terminals.
OK:
Continuity
If there is no continuity, connect the test lead to terminal 5
and the lead to terminal 3. Recheck continuity between terminals.
(+)
Continuity
(–)
3 2 1
(+)
65 4
F00043
NG
Replace ABS solenoid relay.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between DLC1, ABS solenoid relay and body
ground (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
765
DI–531
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Is DTC output?
Check DTC on page DI–493.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
NO
4
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is removed?
NO
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS warning light, DLC1 and ABS
ECU (See page IN–31).
YES
5
Check ABS solenoid relay (See step 2).
NG
Replace ABS solenoid relay.
OK
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between DLC1 and ABS solenoid relay
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
766
DI–532
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03R–03
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting between terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or the DLC2 causes the ECU to display the DTC by
flashing the ABS warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
6
II3
BR
DLC1
A
J/C
BR
A
A
BR
B J/C C
J8
J7
BR
3
E1
Tc
J/C
J3
DLC2
BR
3
LG–R
11
E1
11
II3
LG–R
Tc
B
4
ABS ECU
LG–R 8
A19 Tc
B
B
LG–R
J22: (1MZ–FE)
J23: (5S–FE)
EC
F00113
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
DLC2
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
DLC1
E1
Tc
E1
Tc
F02607 F00445
F02612
OK
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Tc
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
NG
Author:
Date:
767
DI–533
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2 or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
768
DI–534
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03S–03
Ts Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sensor check circuit detects abnormalities in the speed sensor signal which cannot be detected with
the DTC check.
Connecting terminals Ts and E1 of the DLC1 in the engine compartment starts the check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS ECU
DLC1
BR
3
E1
Ts
R–Y
16
8
II3
R–Y
8
A19 Ts
A
J22: (1MZ–FE)
J23: (5S–FE)
J/C
BR
A
EC
F00172
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
E1
Ts
AB0119
S08096
DLC1
F00446
OK
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Ts
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
NG
Author:
Date:
769
DI–535
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC1, DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
770
DI–536
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (DENSO Made)
DI03T–03
Check for Fluid Leakage
Check for fluid leakage from actuator or hydraulic lines.
F00071
Author:
Date:
771
DI–537
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
DI051–04
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manual,
with the page number in the bottom portion. See
the pages for detailed explanations.
1
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–538
2
Check and Clear DTC (Precheck)
P. DI–539
Symptom
does not occur
3
Problem Symptom Confirmation
4
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
7
Problem Symptoms Table
P. DI–545
Symptom
occurs
5
Normal code
DTC Check
P. DI–539
Malfunction code
6
8
DTC Chart
P. DI–542
Circuit Inspection
9
Sensor Check
Check for Fluid Leakage
P. DI–571
P. DI–546 ∼ DI–569
Identification of Problem
10
11
Repair
Confirmation Test
Step 2, 5, 9, 11:
End
Diagnostic steps permitting the use of the
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Author:
Date:
772
DI–538
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI03U–04
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ABS Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem First Occurred
/
Frequency Problem Occurs
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
times a day)
ABS does not operate.
Symptoms
ABS does not operate intermittently.
ABS Warning Light
Abnormal
Remains ON
Does not Light Up
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
DTC Check
Author:
Date:
773
DI–539
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI03V–04
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
F00047
DLC2
Tc
Tc
S−17−1
Check the DTC.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Read the DTC from the ABS warning light on the
combination meter.
HINT:
E1
Iei−23−1−A
HINT:
If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to troubleshooting for the ABS warning light circuit (See page DI–565).
(b)
DLC1
E1
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Check the indicator.
When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 2 seconds.
F00041
Normal Code
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit or ABS
warning light circuit (See page DI–567 or DI–565).
As an example, the blinking patterns for normal code and
codes 11 and 21 are shown on the left.
(4) Codes are explained in the code table on page
DI–542.
(5) After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc
and E1, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time the lowest numbered DTC will be displayed 1st.
Code 11 and 21
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
4 sec.
0.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 11
Code 21
F00103
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
(c)
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester, check the DTC.
(1) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC2.
(2) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
DLC2
H07517
Author:
Date:
774
DI–540
DIAGNOSTICS
(d)
BR3890
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Clear the DTC.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Clear the DTC stored in ECU by depressing the
brake pedal 8 or more times within 3 seconds.
(4) Check that the warning light shows the normal
code.
(5) Remove the SST from the terminals of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
HINT:
Cancellation cannot be done by removing the battery cable or
ECU–B fuse.
2.
(a)
DLC1
E1
Ts
0.13 sec.
Tc
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
Check the speed sensor signal.
(1) When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that
the ABS warning light goes on for 2 seconds.
(2) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(3) Using SST, connect terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(4) Start the engine.
F02201
0.12 sec.
ON
OFF
BR3904
(5) Check that the ABS warning light blinks.
HINT:
If the ABS warning light does not blink, inspect the ABS warning
light circuit (See page DI–565).
(6) Drive vehicle straight forward.
HINT:
Drive vehicle at 45 – 55 km/h (28 – 34 mph) for several seconds.
If the brake is applied during the check, the check routine must
be started again.
(7) Stop the vehicle.
(8) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(9) Disconnect the SST from terminals Ts and E1 and,
connect the SST to terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(10) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(11) Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
Author:
Date:
775
DI–541
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
HINT:
See the list of DTC shown at the bottom of this page.
If every sensor is normal, a normal code is output (A cycle
of 0.25 sec. ON and 0.25 sec. OFF is repeated).
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed 1st.
Malfunction Code (Example Code 72, 76)
7
2
7
6
ON
OFF
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
2.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
Repeat
BR3893
(12) After doing the check, disconnect the SST from terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1, and turn ignition switch
OFF.
SST 09843 – 18020
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
(b)
DLC2
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester, check the DTC.
(1) Do step 1. ∼ 6. on the previous page.
(2) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC2.
(3) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
H07517
DTC of speed sensor check function:
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
71
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Right front speed sensor rotor
72
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Left front speed sensor rotor
73
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Right rear speed sensor rotor
74
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Left rear speed sensor rotor
75
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed
sensor
Right front speed sensor rotor
76
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
Left front speed sensor rotor
77
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
Right rear speed sensor rotor
78
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor rotor
Author:
Date:
776
DI–542
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI03W–11
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Using SST 09843 –18020, connect the terminals Tc and E1.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for the code. For details
of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ”See page” for respective ”DTC No.” in the DTC
chart.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
ABS solenoid valve relay faulty
ABS solenoid valve relay
Valve supply voltage
ECU
13
(DI–548)
ABS pump motor faulty
ABS motor relay
Pump motor voltage
Pump motor lead disconnected
ECU
21
(DI–550)
Right front solenoid valves faulty
ABS actuator (right front inlet or outlet solenoid valve)
22
(DI–550)
Left front solenoid valves faulty
ABS actuator (left front inlet or outlet solenoid valve)
23
(DI–550)
Right rear solenoid valves faulty
ABS actuator (right rear inlet or outlet solenoid valve)
24
(DI–550)
Left rear solenoid valves faulty
ABS actuator (left rear inlet or outlet solenoid valve)
31
(DI–552)
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
32
(DI–552)
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
33
(DI–552)
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
11
(DI–546)
34
(DI–552)
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed
s eed sensor circuit
Sensor installation
ECU
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
35
(DI–552)
Open circuit in right front wheel speed sensor circuit
36
(DI–552)
Open circuit in left front wheel speed sensor circuit
37
(DI–557)
Speed sensor rotor is wrong number of teeth on one of the 4
wheels
38
(DI–552)
Open circuit in right rear wheel speed sensor circuit
39
(DI–552)
Open circuit in left rear wheel speed sensor circuit
Right front, left front speed sensor
Each
E h speed
d sensor circuit
i it
ECU
Speed sensor
Sensor rotor
ECU
Right rear, left rear speed sensor
Each
E h speed
d sensor circuit
i it
ECU
41
(DI–558)
Low battery positive voltage
Battery
Charging system regulator
Power source circuit
ECU
58
(DI–561)
Open circuit in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
ECU
62
(DI–563)
Malfunction in ECU
ECU
Author:
Date:
777
DI–543
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI03X–05
PARTS LOCATION
Sensor Rotor
ABS Warning Light
Front Speed Sensor
ABS Actuator
(w/ ECU, Relay)
DLC1
Rear Speed Sensor
DLC2
Sensor Rotor
Stop Light Switch
Front Speed Sensor
F01175
Author:
Date:
778
DI–544
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI1JN–03
TERMINALS OF ECU
A6
1
2
4
3
5
6
7
8
20
16
17
10
9
21
12
11
22
23
13
24
14
25
15
26
19
18
F00050
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
+B (A6 – 17, 18) – GND (A6 –
16, 19)
L ↔ W–B
IG1 (A6 – 15) – GND (A6 – 16,
19)
B–R ↔ W–B
WA (A6 – 21) – GND (A6 – 16,
26)
R L ↔ W–B
R–L
W B
STP (A6 – 14) – GND (A6 – 16,
19)
G W ↔ W–B
G–W
W B
Tc (A6 – 12) – GND (A6 – 16,
19)
LG–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
5.7 – 8.1
Ts (A6 – 11) – GND (A6 – 16,
19)
R–Y ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
5.7 – 8.1
FR+ (A6 – 5) – FR– (A6 – 4)
W↔B
IG switch ON, slowly turn right front wheel
AC generation
FL+ (A6 – 7) – FL– (A6 – 6)
R↔G
IG switch ON, slowly turn left front wheel
AC generation
RR+ (A6 – 3) – RR– (A6 – 1)
P↔L
IG switch ON, slowly turn right rear wheel
AC generation
RL+ (A6 – 9) RL– (A6 – 8)
Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON, slowly turn left rear wheel
AC generation
Always
10 – 14
IG switch ON
10 – 14
IG switch ON, ABS warning light ON
Below 2.6
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
Stop light switch OFF
Below 1.5
Stop light switch ON
5 – 14
Author:
Date:
779
DI–545
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI03Z–10
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal code is displayed during the DTC check but the problem still occurs, check the circuits for each
problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant troubleshooting page.
Symptom
ABS does not operate
ABS does not operate intermittently
Suspect Area
See page
Only when 1. to 4. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the DTC reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
2. Power source circuit
3. Speed sensor circuit
4. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
Only when 1. το 4. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the DTC reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
2. Speed sensor circuit
3. Stop light switch circuit
4. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
DI–539
DI–558
DI–552
DI–571
DI–539
DI–552
DI–561
DI–571
ABS warning light abnormal
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. ABS ECU
DI–565
DI–563
DTC check cannot be done
Only when 1. and 2. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. Tc terminal circuit
DI–565
DI–567
Speed sensor signal check cannot be done
1. Ts terminal circuit
2. ABS ECU
DI–569
DI–563
Author:
Date:
780
DI–546
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI040–08
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
11
ABS Solenoid Valve Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This relay supplies power to each ABS solenoid. After the ignition switch is turned ON, if the initial check is
OK, the relay goes on.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Detection of any conditions from 1. through 3.:
1. 3 or more solenoid valves are shown faulty in response
and simultaneously valve supply voltage is detected
faulty.
2. Solenoid valve relay will not be switched OFF.
3. Valve relay is frozen in spite of its high valve relay supply voltage.
11
Trouble Area
ABS solenoid valve relay
Valve supply voltage
ECU
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the ABS solenoid valve relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid valve
relay and prohibits ABS control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
L
L
3
ABS
18 A6
+B
2
1
A6 17
+B
Actuator Assembly
Engine
Room R/B
No.3
3
B–G
1 F5
Valve Relay
ECU
ALT
1 F4
B–G
FL
Block
GND1
19
A6
W–B
Motor Relay
MAIN
W–B
Battery
EA
GND2
16 A6
W–B
F03949
Author:
Date:
781
DI–547
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals A6 – 17, 18 and A6 – 16, 19 of ABS actuator
connector.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the ABS actuator connector.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals A6 – 17, 18 and A6 –
16, 19 of ABS actuator harness side connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
LOCK
A6
(–)
17
19 18
16
(+)
F00064
NG
Check and replace fuses.
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
Author:
Date:
782
DI–548
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI041–08
DTC
13
Pump Motor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS motor relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor. While the ABS is activated, the ECU switches
the ABS motor relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
13
Detection of any conditions from (1) through (3):
1. After actuation of the motor relay, pump motor voltage
will not be supplied within 0.4 sec.
2. Pump motor voltage is at a high level, motor relay will
not actuate for 2.5 sec. or more.
3. Pump motor voltage keeps low level for longer than 0.4
sec. and the pump repeats activating for 7 sec. 3 times
maximally. since the last activation, the pump motor has
been gone dead because of short circuit.
Trouble Area
ABS motor relay
Pump motor voltage
Pump motor lead disconnected
ECU
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the ABS motor relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
L
L
3
ABS
18 A6
+B
2
1
A6 17
+B
Actuator Assembly
Engine
Room R/B
No.3
3
B–G
1 F5
Valve Relay
ECU
ALT
1 F4
B–G
FL
Block
GND1
19
A6
W–B
Motor Relay
MAIN
W–B
Battery
EA
GND2
16 A6
W–B
F03949
Author:
Date:
783
DI–549
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals A6 – 17, 18 and A6 – 16, 19 of ABS actuator
connector.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the ABS actuator connector.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals A6 – 17, 18 and A6 –
16, 19 of ABS actuator harness side connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
LOCK
A6
(–)
19
18 17
16
(+)
F00064
NG
Check and replace fuses.
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
Author:
Date:
784
DI–550
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI042–08
DTC
21, 22, 23, 24
ABS Solenoid Valve Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on the wheel
cylinders thus controlling the braking force.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
21, 22, 23, 24
Solenoid valve signal does not match to the check result.
Trouble Area
Each solenoid valve
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the actuator solenoid valve circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid valve
relay and prohibits ABS control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
L
L
3
ABS
18 A6
+B
2
1
A6 17
+B
Actuator Assembly
Engine
Room R/B
No.3
3
B–G
1 F5
Valve Relay
ECU
ALT
1 F4
B–G
FL
Block
GND1
19
A6
W–B
Motor Relay
MAIN
W–B
Battery
EA
GND2
16 A6
W–B
F03949
Author:
Date:
785
DI–551
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check the DTC once more.
PREPARATION:
(a) Clear the DTC (See page DI–539).
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
CHECK:
Turn the ignition switch ON, and check if the same DTC is stored in the memory.
NO
No problem.
YES
Replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
786
DI–552
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI043–04
DTC
31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 38, 39
Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Rotor
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to control
the ABS system. The front and rear rotors each have 48 serrations.
When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor generates an AC voltage.
Since the frequency of this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU
to detect the speed of each wheel.
Speed Sensor
S Magnet
N
Coil
To ECU
Low Speed
High Speed
+V
BR3583
BR3582
–V
F00010
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
31, 32, 33, 34
Detection of any of conditions from 1. through 3.:
1. Vehicle speed is more than 40 km/h (25 mph), pulses
are not input for 0.01 sec.
2. After the initial start or restart and when the vehicle
speed has reached 12 km/h (7 mph), the wheel with 0
km/h (0 mph) of wheel speed is detected.
3. After the initial start or restart and when the vehicle
speed has reached 70 km/h (44 mph), front wheel with 0
km/h (0 mph) of wheel speed is detected.
Right front, left front, right rear, left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor installation
ECU
35, 36, 38, 39
Detecting abnormality in the resistance value of each speed
sensor.
Right front, left front, right rear, left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
ECU
HINT:
DTC No. 31 and 35 are for the right front speed sensor.
DTC No. 32 and 36 are for the left front speed sensor.
DTC No. 33 and 38 are for the right rear speed sensor.
DTC No. 34 and 39 are for the left rear speed sensor.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid valve relay and
prohibits ABS control.
Author:
Date:
787
DI–553
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECU
W
5
A6
FR+
B
4
A6
FR–
2
Right Front
Speed Sensor
1
R
1
IK2
R
7
A6 FL+
G
6
IK2
G
6
A6 FL–
P
2
IL1
P
L
1
IL1
L
Y
3
ID1
Y
BR
9
ID1
BR
2
Left Front
Speed Sensor
1
1
Right Rear
Speed Sensor
2
1
Left Rear
Speed Sensor
2
2
IK3
P
3
A6
RR+
L
1
A6
RR–
3
IK3
Y
9
A6 RL+
9
IK3
BR
8
A6 RL–
6
IK3
F00086
Author:
Date:
788
DI–554
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check speed sensor.
1
2
R14205
1 2
R14213
Front:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the front fender liner.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector.
OK:
Resistance: 0.6 – 2.5 kΩ
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
Rear:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the seat cushion and side seatback.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector.
OK:
Resistance: 1.2 – 2.3 kΩ
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
NG
Replace speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–539).
OK
Author:
Date:
789
DI–555
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between each speed
sensor and ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check speed sensor installation.
CHECK:
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there is
no clearance between the sensor and steering
knuckle or rear axle carrier.
OK
NG
BR3795
NG
Replace speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–539).
OK
4
Check sensor rotor and sensor tip.
R00948
Front:
PREPARATION:
Remove the front drive shaft (See page SA–17 or SA–26).
CHECK:
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches or missing teeth or foreign objects.
PREPARATION:
Remove the front speed sensor (See page BR–68).
CHECK:
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign objects on the sensor tip.
Author:
Date:
790
DI–556
DIAGNOSTICS
R00947
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Rear:
PREPARATION:
Remove the axle hub (See page SA–52).
CHECK:
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches or missing teeth or foreign objects.
PREPARATION:
Remove the rear speed sensor (See page BR–70).
CHECK:
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign objects on the sensor tip.
NG
Replace sensor rotor or speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–539).
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
791
DI–557
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI044–04
DTC
37
Speed Sensor Rotor Faulty
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
37
Detection of any of conditions from 1. through 3.:
1. Occurrence of differential to some degree in the wheel
speed between the front and rear wheels of either left or
right side of the vehicle and the front left and right
wheels. (Detection of differential in mini tire size, spinning wheel and decelerating wheel.)
2. Continuous ABS control for 60 sec. or more.
3. Interference on 1 or more wheels for 20 sec. with the
brake pedal depressed, or for 5 sec. when the brake
pedal is not depressed.
Speed sensor
Sensor rotor
ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check sensor rotor (See page DI–552).
NG
Replace sensor rotor.
OK
2
Check speed sensor (See page DI–552).
NG
Replace speed sensor.
OK
3
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between speed sensor and ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness and connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
792
DI–558
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI045–08
DTC
41
Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the ECU, hence the actuators.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
41
Vehicle speed at about 6 km/h (4 mph), low battery voltage
is less than 9.4 V at the time of non–operation of ABS
control or less than 8.8 V at the time of operation of ABS
control, and high battery voltage is more than 17.4 V.
Trouble Area
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
ECU
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid valve relay and
prohibits ABS control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
L
B–R
L
3
ABS
18 A6
+B
2
1
17
A6
+B IG1
A6 15
5
IK3
J/C
B–R
B–R
C
C
J12
Actuator Assembly
1J
9
Engine
Room R/B
No.3
ECU–IG
3
B–G
1 F5
Instrument
Panel J/B
Valve Relay
ECU
ALT
1 F4
B–G
FL
Block
GND1
Motor Relay
19
A6
W–B
MAIN
W–B
Battery
EA
GND2
16 A6
W–B
F03950
Author:
Date:
793
DI–559
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ECU–IG fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove ECU–IG fuse from Instrument Panel J/B.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
OK:
Continuity
ECU–IG
Instrument
Panel J/B
F00073
NG
Check for short circuit in all the harness and
components connected to ECU–IG fuse (See
the attached wiring diagram.)
NG
Check and repair the charging system
5S–FE engine: (See page CH–1)
1MZ–FE engine: (See page CH–1).
OK
2
Check battery positive voltage.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
OK
Author:
Date:
794
DI–560
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Check voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS actuator connector.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect ABS actuator connector.
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS
actuator harness side connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
IG1
GND
(+)
(–)
F00067
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
4
Check continuity between terminals GND of ABS actuator connector and body
ground.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal GND of ABS actuator
harness side connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 Ω or less
LOCK
(–)
(+)
GND
F00068
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU and ECU–IG
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
795
DI–561
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI046–09
DTC
58
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
ECU
Stop light switch circuit is open, and stop light switch
voltage is in the level between 65 % or more and less
than 93 % of the battery voltage.
49
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECU
J/C
G–W
Instrument
Panel J/B
5 1R
Stop Light Switch
4
G–W
1R
2
1
W
J28
C
J27
A
2
1S
1
G–W
IK3
G–W
STP
G–W
7
R
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1C
STOP
14
A6
Light Failure
Sensor
1
4
1B
G–R 2
G–R
G–R
1
F4
FL Block
ALT
1
F9
B–R
B–G
High
H10 2
Mounted
Stop
H10 1
Light
W–B A
J/C
J40
MAIN
Battery
A
2
2
Right R11
Left R9
Stop
Stop
Light R11 5
Light R9 5
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
BL
BP
F00125
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of stop light.
CHECK:
Check that stop light lights up when brake pedal is depressed and turns off when brake pedal is released.
NG
Repair stop light circuit (See page BE–36).
OK
Author:
Date:
796
DI–562
DIAGNOSTICS
2
(–)
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Check voltage between terminal STP of ABS actuator and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect ABS actuator connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal STP of ABS actuator harness side connector and body ground when brake pedal is depressed.
OK:
Voltage: 8 – 14 V
(+)
STP
F00069
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
3
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU and stop
light switch (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–545).
Author:
Date:
797
DI–563
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI047–06
DTC
62
ABS ECU Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
62
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
ABS ECU continuously detects the proper operation of
ABS.
Battery
ECU
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid valve relay and
prohibits ABS control.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Is DTC output?
Check DTC on page DI–539.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
YES
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between DLC1 or DLC2 and ABS ECU
(See page IN–31).
NO
2
Is normal code displayed?
NO
3
Does ABS warning light go off?
YES
Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector of Tc circuit between ECU and DLC2
or DLC1.
NO
Author:
Date:
798
DI–564
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Check voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS actuator connector.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect ABS actuator connector.
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS
actuator harness side connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
IG1
(+)
(–)
GND
F00067
NG
Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector between ECU–IG fuse and ABS actuator (See page IN–31).
OK
5
Check connection of ABS actuator connector.
CHECK:
Check the connection of the ABS actuator connector and check the ABS warning light goes off.
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector.
NG
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
799
DI–565
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI048–08
ABS Warning Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects any trouble, it lights the ABS warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS control.
At this time, the ECU records a DTC in memory.
Connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or DLC2 to make the ABS warning light blink and output the DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
J/C
D
R–L
ABS
Warning
Light
7
R–L
C10
D
ECU
J/C
J29
4
R–L 12
C10
IG3
R–L
C
R–L
C
J4
10
21
R–L
IK3
A6
WA
C
R–L
14
ABS
2 1D
Instrument
Panel J/B
DLC2
GAUGE
F00096
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Troubleshoot in accordance with the chart below for each trouble symptom
ABS warning light does not light up
Go to step 1
ABS warning light remains on
Go to step 2
1
Check ABS warning light.
See combination meter troubleshooting on page BE–2.
NG
Repair bulb or combination meter assembly.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between GAUGE fuse, DLC2 and ABS ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
800
DI–566
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Is DTC output?
Check DTC on page DI–539.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
NO
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS warning light, DLC1, DLC2, and
ECU (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
801
DI–567
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI049–08
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting between terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or the DLC2 causes the ECU to display the DTC by
flashing the ABS warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECU
6
BR
II3
BR
B
J8
J/C
C
J7
DLC2
BR
3
E1
Tc
LG–R
4 B
J/C
J3
LG–R
B
12
12
LG–R
IK2
A6 Tc
B
A
J/C
A
BR
A
DLC1
BR
3
E1
Tc
P–B (1MZ–FE)
LG–R (5S–FE)
11
11
II3
LG–R
J22: (1MZ–FE)
J23: (5S–FE)
EC
F00120
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
DLC2
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
DLC1
E1
Tc
E1
Tc
F02607 F00445
F02612
OK
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Tc
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
NG
Author:
Date:
802
DI–568
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2 or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
803
DI–569
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI04A–08
Ts Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sensor check circuit detects abnormalities in the speed sensor signal which cannot be detected with
the DTC check.
Connecting terminals Ts and E1 of the DLC1 in the engine compartment starts the check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECU
BR
DLC1 B–Y (1MZ–FE)
LG (5S–FE) 8
E1 Ts
II3
3
16
R–Y
5
IK2
R–Y
11
A6 Ts
A
J/C
A
J22: (1MZ–FE)
J23: (5S–FE)
BR
EC
F00095
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
E1
AB0119
S08096
Ts
DLC1
F00446
OK
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Ts
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
NG
Author:
Date:
804
DI–570
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC1, DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Author:
Date:
805
DI–571
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (BOSCH Made)
DI04B–10
Check for Fluid Leakage
Check for fluid leakage from actuator or hydraulic lines.
F00072
Author:
Date:
806
DI–572
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
DI04C–02
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
2
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manual,
with the page number in the bottom portion. See
the pages for detailed explanations.
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–573
Check and Clear DTC (Precheck)
P. DI–574
Symptom
does not occur
3
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
4
Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom
occurs
5
Normal code
DTC Check
P. DI–574
Malfunction code
6
8
7
DTC Chart
P. DI–578
Circuit Inspection
9
Sensor Check
P.DI–584 ∼ DI–620
Problem Symptoms Table
P. DI–583
Check for Fluid Leakage
P.DI–623
Identification of Problem
10
11
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step 2, 5, 8, 9, 11: Diagnostic steps permitting the use of the
TOYOTA hand–held tester or TOYOTA
break–out–box.
Author:
Date:
807
DI–573
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04D–02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ABS & TRAC Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem First Occurred
/
Frequency Problem Occurs
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
times a day)
ABS does not operate.
ABS does not operate efficiently.
TRAC does not operate. (Wheels spin when starting rapidly.)
Symptoms
Check Item
ABS Warning Light
Abnormal
Remains ON
Does not Light Up
TRAC OFF Indicator
Light Abnormal
Remains ON
Blinks
SLIP Indicator
Light Abnormal
Remains ON
Does not Light Up
Malfunction
Indicator Light
Normal
Malfunction Code (Code
)
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
Does not Light Up
DTC Check
Author:
Date:
808
DI–574
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04E–04
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
F00075
DLC2
E1
Tc
Tc
S−17−1
E1
Iei−23−1−A
F00041
Normal Code
2 sec.
HINT:
If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to troubleshooting for the ABS warning light circuit, TRAC OFF indicator
light circuit and SLIP indicator light circuit
(See page DI–612, DI–617, DI–620).
(b)
DLC1
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Check the indicator.
When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light, TRAC OFF indicator light and SLIP indicator light go on for 3 seconds.
Check the DTC.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Read the DTC from the ABS warning light and
TRAC OFF indicator light on the combination meter.
HINT:
If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit or ABS warning light circuit, TRAC OFF indicator light circuit
(See page DI–621 or DI–612, DI–617).
As an example, the blinking patterns for normal code and codes
11 and 21 are shown on the left.
(4) Codes are explained in the code table on page
DI–578.
(5) After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc
and E1, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time the lowest numbered DTC will be displayed 1st.
Code 11 and 21
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
4 sec.
0.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 11
Code 21
R01346
Author:
Date:
809
DI–575
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
(c)
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester, check the DTC.
(1) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC2.
(2) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(d)
Clear the DTC.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Clear the DTC stored in ECU by depressing the
brake pedal 8 or more times within 5 seconds.
(4) Check that the warning light shows the normal
code.
(5) Remove the SST from the terminals of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(e)
Using TOYOTA break–out–box and TOYOTA hand–held
tester, measure the ECU terminal values.
(1) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester and
TOYOTA break–out–box to the vehicle.
(2) Read the ECU input/output values by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
DLC2
H07517
BR3890
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
ECU
TOYOTA
Break–out–box
N09348
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” function. This records the measured values and is effective in the diagnosis of
intermittent problems.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester/TOYOTA break–
out–box operator’s manual for further details.
Author:
Date:
810
DI–576
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
E1
Ts
DLC1
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
Check the speed sensor signal.
(1) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(3) Start the engine.
Tc
F02201
(4)
0.13 sec.
–
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR3904
Check that the ABS warning light blinks.
HINT:
If the ABS warning light does not blink, inspect the ABS warning
light circuit (See page DI–612).
(5) Drive vehicle straight forward.
HINT:
Drive vehicle faster than 45 km/h (28 mph) for several seconds.
(6) Stop the vehicle.
(7) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(8) Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
HINT:
See the list of DTC shown on the next page.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed 1st.
If every sensor is normal, a normal code is output (A cycle
of 0.25 sec. ON and 0.25 sec. OFF is repeated).
Malfunction Code (Example Code 72, 76)
7
2
7
6
ON
OFF
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
2.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
Repeat
BR3893
(9)
After doing the check, disconnect the SST from terminals Ts and E1, Tc and E1 of DLC1, and turn ignition switch OFF.
SST 09843 – 18020
Author:
Date:
811
DI–577
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
(b)
DLC2
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester, check the DTC.
(1) Do step 1. ∼ 6. on the previous page.
(2) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC2.
(3) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
H07517
DTC of speed sensor check function:
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
71
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Right front speed sensor rotor
72
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Left front speed sensor rotor
73
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Right rear speed sensor rotor
74
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Left rear speed sensor rotor
75
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed
sensor
Right front speed sensor rotor
76
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
Left front speed sensor rotor
77
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
Right rear speed sensor rotor
78
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor rotor
Author:
Date:
812
DI–578
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04F–04
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Using SST 09843 –18020, connect the terminals Tc and E1.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for the code. For details
of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ”See page” for respective ”DTC No.” in the DTC
chart.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
11
(DI–584)
Open circuit in ABS & TRAC solenoid relay circuit
12
(DI–584)
Short circuit in ABS & TRAC solenoid relay circuit
13
(DI–587)
Open circuit in ABS & TRAC motor relay circuit
14
(DI–587)
Short circuit in ABS & TRAC motor relay circuit
21
(DI–590)
Open or short circuit in right front solenoid circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
SFRR or SFRH circuit
ECU
22
(DI–590)
Open or short circuit in left front solenoid circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
SFLR or SFLH circuit
ECU
23
(DI–590)
Open or short circuit in right rear solenoid circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
SRRR or SRRH circuit
ECU
24
(DI–590)
Open or short circuit in left rear solenoid circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
SRLR or SRLH circuit
ECU
25
(DI–590)
Open or short circuit in SMC1 circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
SMC1 circuit
ECU
26
(DI–590)
Open or short circuit in SMC2 circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
SMC2 circuit
ECU
27
(DI–590)
Open or short circuit in SRC1 circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
SRC1 circuit
ECU
28
(DI–590)
Open or short circuit in SRC2 circuit
ABS & TRAC actuator
SRC2 circuit
ECU
31
(DI–593)
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
32
(DI–593)
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
33
(DI–593)
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
34
(DI–593)
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
41
(DI–598)
Low battery positive voltage or abnormally high battery
positive voltage
ABS & TRAC solenoid relay
ABS & TRAC solenoid
l
id relay
l circuit
i it
ECU
ABS & TRAC motor relay
ABS & TRAC motor
t relay
l circuit
i it
ECU
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each speed
s eed sensor circuit
Speed sensor rotor
ECU
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
ECU
Author:
Date:
813
DI–579
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
43*
(DI–601)
Malfunction in ABS control system
ABS control system
44*
(DI–602)
Open or short circuit in NE signal circuit
NEO circuit
ECM
ECU
49
(DI–604)
Open circuit in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
ECU
51
(DI–606)
Pump motor is locked
ABS pump motor
53*
(DI–608)
Malfunction in ECM communication circuit
TRC+ or TRC – circuit
EFI+ or EFI– circuit
ECM
ECU
61*
(DI–609)
Malfunction in engine control system
Engine control system
Malfunction in ECU
ECU
Always ON
(DI–610)
*: TRAC OFF indicator light blinking
Author:
Date:
814
DI–580
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04G–04
PARTS LOCATION
SLIP Indicator Light
TRAC OFF Indicator Light
ABS Warning Light
Sensor Rotor
ABS & TRAC ECU
TRAC OFF Switch
DLC1
Front Speed Sensor
ABS & TRAC Actuator
ABS & TRAC
Solenoid Relay
DLC2
ABS & TRAC
Motor Relay
Sensor Rotor
Front Speed Sensor
Rear Speed Sensor
Stop Light Switch
F01177
Author:
Date:
815
DI–581
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI1JO–03
TERMINALS OF ECU
A15
13 12 11 10 9
8
7
A16
6
5
4
3
2
1
26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14
8
7
6
5
4
A17
3
2
1
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
3
2
1
12 11 10 9
8
7
6
5
4
R05698
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
IG1 (A16 – 8) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
B–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
10 – 14
R+ (A15 – 1) – SR (A15 – 11)
GR–R ↔ GR
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
9 – 14
R+ (A15 – 1) – MR (A15 – 24)
GR–R ↔ GR–L
SFRR (A15 – 26) – GND (A15
– 15, A17 – 9, 10)
W–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFRH (A15 – 13) – GND (A15
– 15, A17 – 9, 10)
R–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFLR (A17 – 1) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
W–L ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFLH (A17 – 2) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
L–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRRR (A17 – 7) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
R–G ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRRH (A17 – 8) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
W–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRLR (A15 – 12) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
LG–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRLH (A15 – 25) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
G–Y ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
AST (A15 – 10) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
WA (A16 – 4) – GND (A15 – 15,
A17 – 9, 10)
G B ↔ W–B
G–B
W B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light ON
Below 2.0
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
STP (A16 – 16) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
G W ↔ W–B
G–W
W B
D/G (A15 – 22) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
R–L ↔ W–B
Tc (A15 – 9) – GND (A15 – 15,
A17 – 9, 10)
IG switch ON
Below 1.0
Stop light switch OFF
Below 1.5
Stop light switch ON
8 – 14
IG switch ON, ABS warning light ON
10 – 14
LG–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
8 – 14
Ts (A15 – 23) – GND (A15 – 15,
A17 – 9, 10)
R–Y ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
8 – 14
FR+ (A15 – 17) – FR– (A15 –
18)
W↔B
IG switch ON, slowly turn right front wheel
AC generation
FL+ (A15 – 5) – FL– (A15 – 4)
R↔G
IG switch ON, slowly turn left front wheel
AC generation
RR+ (A16 – 9) – RR– (A16 –
10)
W↔B
IG switch ON, slowly turn right rear wheel
AC generation
RL+ (A16 – 2) – RL– (A16 – 1)
R↔G
IG switch ON, slowly turn left rear wheel
AC generation
Author:
Date:
816
DI–582
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
MT (A15 – 14) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
R–W ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
SRC1 (A17 – 5) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
B–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, TRAC OFF indicator light OFF
10 – 14
SRC2 (A17 – 6) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
B–Y ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, TRAC OFF indicator light OFF
10 – 14
SMC1 (A17 – 12) – GND (A15
– 15, A17 – 9, 10)
Y–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, TRAC OFF indicator light OFF
10 – 14
SMC2 (A17 – 6) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
Y–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, TRAC OFF indicator light OFF
10 – 14
NEO (A16 – 15) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
BR–W ↔ W–B
EFI+ (A16 – 6) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
Below 1.5
Idling
Pulse generation
W ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
EFI– (A16 – 14) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
Pulse generation
TRC+ (A16 – 13) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
G ↔ W–B
TRAC control active
Pulse generation
TRC– (A16 – 5) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
L ↔ W–B
TRAC control active
Pulse generation
IND (A16 – 3) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
LG ↔ W–B
W B
WT (A16 – 12) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
L↔W
W–B
B
CSW (A16 – 11) – GND (A15 –
15, A17 – 9, 10)
LG ↔ W–B
W B
IG switch ON, SLIP indicator light ON
Below 2.0
IG switch ON, SLIP indicator light OFF
10 – 14
IG switch ON, TRAC OFF indicator light ON
Below 2.0
IG switch ON, TRAC OFF indicator light OFF
10 – 14
IG switch ON, TRAC cut switch pushed in
Below 2.0
IG switch ON, TRAC cut switch released
8 – 14
Author:
Date:
817
DI–583
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04I–04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal code is displayed during the DTC check but the problem still occurs, check the circuits for each
problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant troubleshooting page.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
ABS does not operate.
Only when 1. to 4. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the
ABS & TRAC ECU.
1. Check the DTC reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
2. IG power source circuit
3. Speed sensor circuit
4. Check the ABS & TRAC actuator with a checker. If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
(See page DI–623).
ABS does not operate efficiently.
Only when 1. to 4. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the
ABS & TRAC ECU.
1. Check the DTC reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
2. Speed sensor circuit.
3. Stop light switch circuit.
4. Check the ABS & TRAC actuator with a checker. If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
(See page DI–623).
ABS warning light abnormal.
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. ABS & TRAC ECU
DI–612
DI–610
DTC check cannot be done.
Only when 1. and 2. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS & TRAC ECU.
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. TRAC OFF indicator light circuit
3. Tc terminal circuit
DI–612
DI–617
DI–621
Speed sensor signal check cannot be done.
1. Ts terminal circuit
2. ABS & TRAC ECU
DI–615
DI–610
TRAC does not operate.
Only when inspection circuits for each problem symptom
are all normal and the problem is still occurring, replace the
ABS & TRAC ECU.
1. Check the DTC, reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
2. IG power source circuit
3. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
4. Speed sensor circuit
DI–574
DI–598
DI–593
BR–61
DI–574
DI–593
DI–604
BR–61
DI–574
DI–598
DI–623
DI–593
SLIP indicator light abnormal.
SLIP indicator light circuit
DI–620
TRAC OFF indicator light abnormal.
Only when inspection circuits for each problem symptom
are all normal and the problem is still occurring, replace the
ABS & TRAC ECU.
1. TRAC OFF indicator light circuit
2. TRAC cut switch circuit
DI–617
DI–617
Author:
Date:
818
DI–584
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04J–04
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
11, 12
ABS & TRAC Solenoid Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This relay supplies power to each ABS & TRAC solenoid. After the ignition switch is turned ON, if the initial
check is OK, the relay goes on.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
11
Condition 1. to 3. are detected:
1. Malfunction of solenoid relay monitor
2. Battery voltage will not exceed more than 17.0 V within
2.16 sec.
3. Battery voltage will not become less than 9.5 V within
2.16 sec., or after the solenoid relay is ON and AST
voltage of ECU terminal does not become 8.0 V or more.
12
Solenoid relay is OFF in the midst of premain routine, and
AST voltage of ECU terminal is 8.0 V or more, which continues for 2.04 sec. or more.
ABS & TRAC solenoid relay
ABS & TRAC solenoid relay circuit
ECU
Fail safe function:
If any trouble occurs in the ABS & TRAC solenoid relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS & TRAC
solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control and TRAC control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC
ECU
Engine Room R/B No. 3
ABS & TRAC Solenoid Relay
6
1
4
2
2
ABS
3
3
5
GR
GR–R
3
1
11
A15 SR
1
A15 R+
DLC1
3
3
3
W–L
ABS & TRAC
4 A8 Actuator
B–G
1 F5
ALT
Battery
3
W–B
ABS & TRAC
ECU
FL
Block
1 F4
B–G
MAIN
EA
5
A8
R
10
A15 AST
F03951
Author:
Date:
819
DI–585
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of Engine Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS &
TRAC solenoid relay).
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS & TRAC solenoid relay from Engine Room R/B
No. 3.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of Engine
Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS & TRAC solenoid relay).
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
(–)
(+)
123
456
Engine Room R/B No. 3
F00182
NG
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
2
Check continuity between terminal 3 of ABS & TRAC solenoid relay and terminal
AST of ABS & TRAC ECU.
Engine Room R/B No. 3
ABS & TRAC
Solenoid
Relay
ABS & TRAC
3
A8
Actuator
4
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal 3 of Engine Room R/B No.
3 (for ABS solenoid relay) and terminal AST of ABS & TRAC
ECU.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
There is a resistance of 4 ∼ 6 Ω between terminals A8 – 4 and
A8 – 5 of ABS actuator.
A8
5
A15
ECU
AST
F00055
NG
Repair or replace harness or ABS & TRAC
actuator.
OK
Author:
Date:
820
DI–586
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check ABS & TRAC solenoid relay.
3
2
1
6
5
4
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS & TRAC solenoid relay.
OK:
Open
Terminals 4 and 6
Continuity (Reference value 80 Ω)
Terminals 2 and 3
Continuity
Terminals 1 and 3
Open
3 2 1
Continuity
Continuity
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 4 and 6.
(b) Check continuity between each terminal of ABS & TRAC
solenoid relay.
OK:
6 5 4
Continuity
3 2 1
Terminals 2 and 3
Open
Terminals 1 and 3
Continuity
Open
(–)
6 5
4
(+)
F00042
NG
Replace ABS & TRAC solenoid relay.
OK
4
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS &
TRAC solenoid relay and ABS & TRAC ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
Author:
Date:
821
DI–587
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04K–04
DTC
13, 14
ABS & TRAC Motor Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS & TRAC motor relay supplies power to the ABS & TRAC pump motor. While the ABS is activated,
the ECU switches the ABS & TRAC motor relay ON and operates the ABS & TRAC pump motor.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
13
Conditions 1. to 3. are detected:
1. Malfunction of motor relay monitor
2. Battery voltage will not exceed more than 17.0 V within
2.16 sec.
3. Battery voltage will not become less than 9.5 V within
2.16 sec., or after the motor relay is ON and motor relay
monitor does not ON.
14
Motor relay is OFF, and motor relay monitor is ON , which
continues for 20.16 sec. or more.
ABS & TRAC motor relay
ABS & TRAC motor relay circuit
ECU
Fail safe function:
If any trouble occurs in the ABS & TRAC motor relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS & TRAC
solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control and TRAC control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
B–G
3
Engine Room R/B No. 3
ABS & TRAC
Motor Relay
2
1
4
1
ABS & TRAC ECU
3
GR–L
24
A15 MR
GR–R
1
A15 R+
R–W
14
A15 MT
ABS
3
1 F5
FL
Block
1 F4
3
3
2
ALT
ABS & TRAC Actuator
B–G
W–R
2
A8
3
A8
MAIN
1 A8
W–B
Battery
EA
F03413
Author:
Date:
822
DI–588
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal 1 of Engine Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS & TRAC
motor relay) and body ground.
(–)
(+)
Engine Room
R/B No. 3
1
2
3 4
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS & TRAC motor relay from Engine Room R/B No.
3.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of Engine Room R/B No.
3 (for ABS & TRAC motor relay) and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
F00049
NG
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
2
Check continuity between terminal 2 of ABS & TRAC motor relay and terminal
MT of ABS & TRAC ECU.
Engine Room R/B
No. 3
2
ABS & TRAC
Motor
Relay
2
A8
2
M
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal 2 of Engine Room R/B No.
3 (for ABS & TRAC motor relay) and terminal MT of ABS &
TRAC ECU.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
There is a resistance of 4 ∼ 6 Ω between terminals A8 – 2 and
A8 – 3 of ABS & TRAC actuator.
A8
ABS & TRAC
Actuator
3
3
A15
ECU
MT
F00056
NG
Repair or replace harness or ABS & TRAC
actuator.
OK
Author:
Date:
823
DI–589
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check ABS & TRAC motor relay.
2
1
4
3
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS & TRAC motor
relay.
OK:
Open
2
Continuity
Continuity (Reference value 62 Ω)
Terminals 1 and 2
Open
1
4
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 3 and 4.
(b) Check continuity between terminals of ABS & TRAC motor relay.
OK:
3
Continuity
2
1
Terminals 1 and 2
NG
(–)
Terminals 3 and 4
4
Continuity
Replace ABS & TRAC motor relay.
3
(+)
F00044
OK
4
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS &
TRAC motor relay and ABS & TRAC ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
Author:
Date:
824
DI–590
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04L–04
DTC
21 to 28
ABS & TRAC Actuator Solenoid Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on the wheel
cylinders thus controlling the braking force.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
21
ABS actuator
SFRR or SFRH circuit
ECU
22
ABS actuator
SFLR or SFLH circuit
ECU
23
ABS actuator
SRRR or SRRH circuit
ECU
24
25
26
Conditions 1. and 2. or 3. continue for 0.48 sec. or more:
1 Recovery prohibit run pulse is not output
1.
output, solenoid relay
is ON, AST voltage of ECU terminal is 8.0 V or more,
and solenoid output has no change between the last
time and this time.
2. Solenoid output is ON, pressure holding solenoid monitor voltage is more than 1.0 V or pressure eduction solenoid monitor voltage
g is more than 1.5 V.
3. Solenoid output is OFF, solenoid monitor voltage is more
than –1.0 V AST voltage of ECU.
ABS actuator
SRLR or SRLH circuit
ECU
ABS actuator
SMC1 circuit
ECU
ABS actuator
SMC2 circuit
ECU
27
ABS actuator
SRC1 circuit
ECU
28
ABS actuator
SRC2 circuit
ECU
Fail safe function:
If any trouble occurs in the actuator solenoid circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS & TRAC solenoid
relay and prohibits ABS control and TRAC control.
Author:
Date:
825
DI–591
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC ECU
11
GR
GR–R
3
3
ABS & TRAC
4
6
4 A8
3
9
A7
5
A7
Solenoid
1
2
3
A7
3
3
B–G
A7
A7
W–L
1 F5
A7
W–B
A7
ALT
FL
A7
Block
MAIN
10
G–Y
25
12
L–B
2
11
W–R
8
3
W–R
26
4
LG–B
12
6
W–L
1
5
R–G
7
7
B–R
5
2
B–Y
4
8
Y–R
12
1
Y–B
6
R
10
A7
1
3
Battery
A15
R+
A7
1 F4
EA
A7
5
A8
B–G
13
R–B
A7
2
ABS
SR
DLC1
Engine Room R/B No. 3
Relay
A15
1
ABS & TRAC Actuator
A15
SFRH
A15
SRLH
A17
SFLH
A17
SRRH
A15
SFRR
A15
SRLR
A17
SFLR
A17
SRRR
A17
SRC1
A17
SRC2
A17
SMC1
A17
SMC2
A15
AST
F03952
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ABS & TRAC actuator solenoid.
6 5 4 3 2
1
A8
A7
12 11 10 9 8
7
4
F00057
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS & TRAC actuator.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals A8 – 4 and A7 – 1, 2, 3, 4,
5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 of ABS & TRAC actuator connector.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
Resistance of each solenoid coil is 1.2 Ω.
NG
Replace ABS & TRAC actuator.
OK
Author:
Date:
826
DI–592
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS &
TRAC ECU and actuator (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
Author:
Date:
827
DI–593
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI1JP–03
DTC
Speed Sensor Circuit
31, 32, 33, 34
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Rotor
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to control
the ABS and TRAC system. The front and rear rotors each have
48 serrations.
When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor generates an AC voltage.
Since the frequency of this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU
to detect the speed of each wheel.
Speed Sensor
S Magnet
N
Coil
To ECU
Low Speed
High Speed
+V
BR3583
BR3582
–V
F00010
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
31, 32, 33, 34
Detection of any of conditions from 1. through 3.:
1. ABS is in non–operation, wheel speed is 10 km/h or
more, one eighth of maximum wheel speed is greater
than the minimum wheel speed, one eighth of maximum
wheel speed is smaller than the rear maximum wheel
speed or momentary interruption of both the rear wheels
are shown in the 15 sec. or more continuously.
2. ABS is in non–operation, momentary interruption of
speed sensor occurs 7 times or more in the mean time
of switching the ignition switch ON and OFF or vehicle
speed is 20 km/h (12 mph) or more and the condition of
noise interference or non–noise interference occurs 75
times or more within 5 sec.
3. Vehicle is at a stop, malfunction signal of vehicle speed
sensor hardware open circuit is ON for 1.02 sec. continuously since starting the checking of a certain vehicle.
Trouble Area
Right front, left front, right rear, left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Speed sensor rotor
ECU
HINT:
DTC No. 31 is for the right front speed sensor.
DTC No. 32 is for the left front speed sensor.
DTC No. 33 is for the right rear speed sensor.
DTC No. 34 is for the left rear speed sensor.
Fail safe function:
If any trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS & TRAC solenoid relay
and prohibits ABS control and TRAC control.
Author:
Date:
828
DI–594
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC ECU
17
A15 FR+
W
2
Right Front
Speed Sensor
18
B
A15 FR–
1
R
Left Front
Speed Sensor
2
G
1
W*1
P*2
Right Rear
Speed Sensor
1
B*1
Y*2
2
W*1
Y*2
Left Rear
Speed Sensor
2
G*1
BR*2
1
*1:
*2:
1
IK2
6
IK2
R
5
A15 FL+
G
4
A15 FL–
2
IL1
W
1
IL1
B
3
ID1
R
9
ID1
G
9
A16 RR+
10
A16 RR–
2
A16 RL+
1
A16 RL–
TMC Made
TMMK Made
F00116
Author:
Date:
829
DI–595
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check speed sensor.
1
2
R14205
1 2
R14213
Front:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the front fender liner.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector.
OK:
Resistance: 0.6 – 2.5 kΩ
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
Rear:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the seat cushion and side seatback.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector.
OK:
Resistance: 1.2 – 2.3 kΩ
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
NG
Replace speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–574).
OK
Author:
Date:
830
DI–596
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between each speed
sensor and ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check sensor installation.
CHECK:
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there is
no clearance between the sensor and steering
knuckle or rear axle carrier.
OK
NG
BR3795
NG
Replace speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–574).
OK
4
Check speed sensor and sensor rotor serrations.
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
2 m/s / Division
1 V / Division
REFERENCE: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ABS & TRAC ECU.
(b) Connect the oscilloscope to the terminals FR+, FL+, RR+
or RL+ and GND of the ABS & TRAC ECU.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle with about 30 km/h (19 mph), and check the
signal waveform.
W04200
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
NG
Author:
Date:
831
DI–597
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check sensor rotor and sensor tip.
R00948
R00947
Front:
PREPARATION:
Remove front drive shaft (See page SA–26).
CHECK:
Check sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches , missing teeth or foreign objects.
PREPARATION:
Remove the front speed sensor (See page BR–68).
CHECK:
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign objects on the sensor tip.
Rear:
PREPARATION:
Remove the axle hub (See page SA–52).
CHECK:
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches , missing teeth or foreign objects.
PREPARATION:
Remove the rear speed sensor (See page BR–71).
CHECK:
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign objects on the sensor tip.
NG
Replace sensor rotor or speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last. (See page DI–574).
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
Author:
Date:
832
DI–598
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04N–04
DTC
41
IG Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the ECU, hence the actuators.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
41
Detection of any conditions from 1. through 3.:
1. Vehicle speed is 3 km/h (1.9 mph) or more and battery
voltage is less than 9.5 V continues for 10 sec. or more.
2. Battery voltage has never exceeded more than 17.0 V
and has become less than 9.5 V within 2.16 sec., under
malfunction of solenoid relay monitor after the solenoid
relay is ON, at ECU AST terminal voltage of ECU has
become 8.0 V or more or under malfunction of motor
relay monitor and after the motor relay is ON, motor
relay monitor has become ON.
3. Battery voltage is more than 17.0 V , which continues for
1.2 sec. or more or battery voltage has become more
than 17.0 V within 2.16 sec. and solenoid or motor relay
monitor is under malfunction condition.
Trouble Area
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
ECU
Fail safe function:
If any trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS & TRAC solenoid relay
and prohibits ABS control and TRAC control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC ECU
Ignition
Switch
Instrument Panel J/B
W
2
4
FL Block
ALT
B–R
B–R
C
ECU–IG
Instrument Panel J/B
2
1K
AM1
1
F4
9
1J
1
1K
B–Y
J/C
J12
1
1B
B–R
1
F9
W–B
C
8
A16 IG1
W–B
15
A15 GND1
W–B
9
A17 GND3
W–B
10
A17 GND2
W–B
B–G
MAIN
Battery
EA
F00175
Author:
Date:
833
DI–599
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ECU–IG fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove ECU–IG fuse from Instrument Panel J/B.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
OK:
Continuity
ECU–IG
Instrument
Panel J/B
F00073
NG
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to ECU–IG fuse (See attached
wiring diagram).
NG
Check and repair the charging system
5S–FE engine: (See page CH–1)
1MZ–FE engine: (See page CH–1).
OK
2
Check battery positive voltage.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
OK
Author:
Date:
834
DI–600
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS & TRAC ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS & TRAC ECU with connectors still connected.
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS
& TRAC ECU connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
IG1
(+)
(–)
GND
F00058
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
NG
4
Check continuity between terminals GND of ABS & TRAC ECU connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from the ABS & TRAC ECU.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal GND of ABS & TRAC
ECU connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 Ω or less
LOCK
(–)
(+)
GND
F07003
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS & TRAC ECU and battery
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
835
DI–601
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04O–04
DTC
43
ABS Control System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
43
Detection of any conditions from 1. through 8.:
1. During TRAC is in non–operation and DTC of ABS is
output, but TRAC is not during initial lamp checking,
terminal WA of ECU is ON and engine speed is 500 rpm
or more , which continues for 1 sec. or more.
2. Solenoid relay circuit is open or short.
3. Motor relay circuit is open or short.
4. ABS solenoid circuit is open or short.
5. TRAC solenoid circuit is open or short.
6. Speed sensor is under malfunction condition.
7. IG power source is down or raised.
8. Pump motor is locked.
ABS control system
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check the DTC for the ABS (See page DI–574).
*1
Repair ABS control system according to the
code output.
*2
Check for ECU connected to malfunction indicator lamp.
*1: Output NG code
*2: Malfunction indicator lamp remains ON.
Author:
Date:
836
DI–602
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04P–04
DTC
44
NE Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS & TRAC ECU receives engine speed signals (NE signals) from the ECM.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
44
Condition 1. or 2. is detected:
1. TRAC is in operation and engine speed is 0 rpm continues for 2.4 sec. or more.
2. TRAC is in non–operation, sift lever is not in P or N position, both the front right and left wheels’ speed is 30
km/h (19 mph) or more, engine speed is 0 rpm and does
not have communication malfunction, and malfunction
information of engine system is OFF.
Trouble Area
NEO circuit
ECM
ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC ECU
ECM
16
NEO E8
BR–W
15
A16
NEO
F00062
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between terminal
NEO of ABS & TRAC ECU and terminal NEO of ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
837
DI–603
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal NEO of ABS & TRAC ECU and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove ABS & TRAC ECU with connectors still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal NEO of ABS & TRAC ECU
and body ground for the engine conditions below.
OK:
ON
(–)
(+)
NEO
F00061
Engine condition
Voltage
OFF (IG ON)
3 – 6 V or below 1 V
ON (Idling)
2 – 3 V (Pulse)
(Reference)
3–6V
Below 1 V
3 ms. 3 ms.
F00011
NG
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU or ECM.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
Author:
Date:
838
DI–604
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04Q–04
DTC
49
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
49
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Battery voltage has never exceeded more than 17.0 V and
become less than 9.5 V within 2.16 sec. and the STP
terminal voltage of ECU is under open circuit detecting
limits continues for 3 sec. or more.
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC ECU
J/C
Instrument
Panel J/B
Stop
Light
Switch
J28
C
J27
A
4
1R
G–W
1
2
1S
16
A16 STP
G–W
7
R
Instrument Panel J/B
1
4
1B
7
1C
W–B
STOP
1
F4
G–W
5 1R
W
2
G–W
FL Block
ALT
B–R
1
F9
B–G
High
H10 2
Mounted
Stop
H10 1
Light
W–B A
J/C
J40
MAIN
Battery
A
2
Light
Failure
Sensor
W–B
W–B
2 R11 Right 2 R9
Left
Stop
Stop
Light
5 R9 Light
5 R11
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
BP
BL
F00124
Author:
Date:
839
DI–605
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal STP of ABS & TRAC ECU and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS & TRAC ECU with connectors still connected.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal STP of ABS & TRAC ECU
and body ground when brake pedal is depressed.
OK:
Voltage: 8 – 14 V
(–)
(+)
STP
F00060
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
NG
2
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS & TRAC ECU and
stop light switch (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table
(See page DI–583).
Author:
Date:
840
DI–606
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI4KX–01
DTC
51
ABS Pump Motor Lock
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
In the midst of initial check, after the current flows to the
motor for 3 sec. and motor relay is turned OFF , then
within 0.66 sec., the condition that the motor relay
monitor is OFF continues for 0.24 sec. or more.
51
ABS pump motor
Fail safe function:
If any trouble occurs in the ABS & TRAC pump motor, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS & TRAC solenoid
relay and prohibits ABS control and TRAC control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B No. 3
ABS
B–G
3
3
4
2
1
2
3
1 F5
ALT
1
ABS & TRAC ECU
ABS & TRAC
Motor Relay
3
3
GR–L
24
A15 MR
GR–R
1
A15 R+
FL
Block
1 F4
ABS & TRAC Actuator
B–G
W–R
3
A8
2
A8
R–W
14
A15 MT
MAIN
1 A8
W–B
Battery
EA
F03413
Author:
Date:
841
DI–607
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of ABS & TRAC pump motor.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the ABS & TRAC actuator connector.
CHECK:
Connect positive lead to terminal A8 – 2 and negative lead
to terminal A8 – 1 of the ABS & TRAC actuator connector, check
that the pump motor is operates.
A8
1
2
(–)
(+)
F03291
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS & TRAC motor relay, ABS &
TRAC actuator and ECU (See page IN–31).
NG
Replace ABS & TRAC actuator.
Author:
Date:
842
DI–608
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04S–04
DTC
53
ECM Communication Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit is used to send TRAC control information from the ABS & TRAC ECU to the ECM (TRC+, TRC–),
and engine control information from the ECM to the ABS & TRAC ECU (EFI+, EFI–).
DTC No.
53
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
TRC+ or TRC– circuit
EFI+ or EFI– circuit
ECM
ECU
ECM communication data malfunction is detected.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC ECU
ECM
EFI+
14
E7
W
6
21
E7
B
14
EFI–
13
E7
LG
13
TRC+
TRC–
20
E7
L
A16
A16
A16
EFI+
EFI–
TRC+
5
A16
TRC–
F00063
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between terminals
EFI+, EFI–, TRC+, TRC– of ABS & TRAC ECU and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM or ABS & TRAC ECU.
Author:
Date:
843
DI–609
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04T–04
DTC
61
Engine Control System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If any trouble occurs in the engine control system, the ECU prohibits TRAC control.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
61
Conditions 1. and 2. are detected:
1. ECM communication is normal, malfunction information
of engine system is ON, and engine speed is 500 rpm or
more , which continues for 0.48 sec. or more, and TRAC
operation start condition is concluded.
2. ECM communication is normal, malfunction information
of engine system is ON, engine speed is 500 rpm and
more which continues for 1 sec. or more, and the engine
system memorizes DTC.
Trouble Area
Engine control system
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check the DTC for the engine (See page DI–197).
*1
Repair engine control system according to the
code output.
*2
Check for ECU connected to malfunction indicator light.
*1: Output NG code
*2: Malfunction indicator light remains ON.
Author:
Date:
844
DI–610
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI1JQ–03
DTC
Always ON
ABS & TRAC ECU Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
Always ON
DTC Detecting Condition
ABS & TRAC ECU internal malfunction is detected.
Trouble Area
ECU
Fail safe function:
If any trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS & TRAC solenoid relay
and prohibits ABS control and TRAC control.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Is DTC output?
Check DTC on page DI–574.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
YES
Check solenoid relay. Check for short circuit in
harness and connector between solenoid relay
and DLC1 (See page IN–31).
NO
2
Is normal code displayed?
NO
3
Does ABS warning light go off?
YES
Check for open and short circuit in harness and
connector between ECU–IG fuse and ABS &
TRAC ECU (See page IN–31).
NO
Author:
Date:
845
DI–611
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check battery positive voltage.
CHECK:
Check the battery positive voltage.
OK:
10 – 14 V
NG
Check and repair the charging system
5S–FE engine: (See page CH–1)
1MZ–FE engine: (See page CH–1).
OK
5
Check ABS warning light.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the connector from the ABS & TRAC ECU.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check the ABS warning light goes off.
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
NG
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS warning light, DLC1, DLC2, and
ABS & TRAC ECU (See page IN–31)
Author:
Date:
846
DI–612
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04V–04
ABS Warning Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects a trouble, it lights the ABS warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS control.
At this time, the ECU records a DTC in memory.
Connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or DLC2 to make the ABS warning light blink and output the DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B No. 3
Instrument Panel J/B
2
ABS & TRAC
Solenoid Relay
1
Battery
6
4
2
5
GAUGE
3
3
3
4 A8
J/C
J4
D
R–L
3
W–L
D
ABS & TRAC
ECU
8
R–L
R–L
IK2
3
3
R–L
1D
C10 7
4 II3
R–L
ABS & TRAC
Actuator
ABS Warning Light
23
C10 4
DLC1
R–L
22
G–B
12 IG3
Short
Pin
W–B
ABS & TRAC
5 II3
ECU
ABS & TRAC ECU
G–B
C
EA
G–B
C
G–B
C
4
A16 WA
J/C
J29
F00168
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Troubleshoot in accordance with the chart below for each trouble symptom.
ABS warning light does not light up
Go to step 1
ABS warning light remains on
Go to step 3
1
Check ABS warning light.
See combination meter troubleshooting on page BE–2.
NG
Repair bulb or combination meter assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
847
DI–613
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check ABS & TRAC solenoid relay.
3
2
1
6
5
4
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS & TRAC solenoid relay from Engine Room R/B
No. 3.
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS & TRAC solenoid relay.
OK:
Open
3 2 1
Continuity
Continuity
6 5 4
3 2 1
Open
6 5
Continuity (Reference value 80 Ω)
Terminals 2 and 3
Continuity
Terminals 1 and 3
Open
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 4 and 6.
(b) Check continuity between each terminal of ABS & TRAC
solenoid relay.
OK:
Continuity
(–)
Terminals 4 and 6
Terminals 2 and 3
Open
Terminals 1 and 3
Continuity
4
(+)
Continuity
(–)
3 21
(+)
654
F00043
CHECK:
Connect the test lead to terminal 5 and the lead to terminal
3. Check continuity between the terminals.
OK:
Continuity
If there is no continuity, connect the test lead to terminal 5
and the lead to terminal 3. Recheck continuity between terminals.
NG
Replace ABS & TRAC solenoid relay.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between DLC1, ABS & TRAC solenoid relay and
body ground (See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
848
DI–614
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Is DTC output?
Check DTC on page DI–574.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
NO
4
Does ABS warning light go off?
NO
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS warning light, DLC1 and ABS
& TRAC ECU (See page IN–31).
YES
5
Check ABS & TRAC solenoid relay (See step 2).
NG
Replace ABS & TRAC solenoid relay.
OK
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between DLC1 and ABS & TRAC solenoid relay
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
849
DI–615
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04X–04
Ts Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sensor check circuit detects abnormalities in the speed sensor signal which cannot be detected with
the DTC check.
Connecting terminals Ts and E1 of the DLC1 in the engine compartment starts the check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC ECU
DLC1
BR
3
E1
Ts
R–Y
16
11
II3
R–Y
5
IK2
R–Y
23
A15 Ts
A
J22
J/C
BR
A
EC
F00095
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
ON
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
Ts
E1
AB0119
S08096
DLC1
F00446
OK
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Ts
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
NG
Author:
Date:
850
DI–616
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS &
TRAC ECU and DLC1, DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
Author:
Date:
851
DI–617
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04Y–04
TRAC OFF Indicator, TRAC Cut Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the TRAC control main switch. When the TRAC cut switch is pushed on, TRAC control goes off and
the TRAC OFF indicator lights up. This indicator blinks for warnings when the trouble occurs and for
displaying DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS & TRAC ECU
TRAC OFF
Indicator Light
Instrument Panel J/B
J/C
19
3
7
2
L
R–L
R–L
IG3
C10
1D
C10
D
D
GAUGE
J4
Instrument Panel J/B
J/C
IG
W–B
A
7
1J
8
1J
L
J11
J7
A
J/C
C
J32
L
17
J8
A
12
A16 WT
L
DLC2
C J32
J/C
W–B
C
J32
TRC
TRAC Cut Switch
11
LG
W–B
A16 CSW
1
4
F00114
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check DTC.
Check DTC on page DI–574.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
NO
Author:
Date:
852
DI–618
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check TRAC cut switch.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove TRAC cut switch.
(b) Disconnect TRAC cut switch connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 4 of TRAC cut
switch when TRAC cut switch is ON and OFF.
OK:
32
4
(+)
1
(–)
F00052
NG
TRAC cut switch
Resistance
Pushed in
Continuity
Released
1 MΩ or higher
Replace TRAC cut switch.
OK
3
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between terminal
CSW of ABS & TRAC ECU and TRAC cut switch and body ground (See page
IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
4
Check TRAC OFF indicator light.
See combination meter troubleshooting on page BE–2.
NG
Repair or replace combination meter.
OK
Author:
Date:
853
DI–619
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between terminal WT
of ABS & TRAC ECU and TRAC OFF indicator light (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
Author:
Date:
854
DI–620
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI04Z–04
SLIP Indicator Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SLIP indicator blinks during TRAC operation.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
SLIP Indicator Light
J/C
5
7
GAUGE 2
R–L
R–L
LG
C10
1D
C8
D
D
J4
ABS & TRAC ECU
18
IG3
LG
3
A16 IND
F00097
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check SLIP indicator light.
See combination meter troubleshooting on page BE–2.
NG
Repair or replace combination meter.
OK
2
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS & TRAC ECU and
SLIP indicator light (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
Author:
Date:
855
DI–621
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI4KY–01
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting between terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or the DLC2 causes the ECU to display the DTC by
blinking the ABS warning light and TRAC OFF indicator light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
J/C
6
II3
BR
BR
J7
C
DLC1
A
BR
J/C
J22
3
A
BR
J8
B
DLC2
BR
E1
3
LG–R*1
P–B*2
Tc
11
E1
Tc
ABS & TRAC ECU
J/C
J3
LG–R
4 B
LG–R
B
12 LG–R 9
IK2
A15 Tc
B
11
II3
LG–R
A
EC
*1: TMC Made
*2: TMMK Made
F00120
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
DLC2
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
DLC1
E1
Tc
E1
Tc
F02607 F00445
F02612
OK
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Tc
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
NG
Author:
Date:
856
DI–622
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS &
TRAC ECU and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2 or DLC1 and body ground (See page
IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ABS & TRAC ECU.
Author:
Date:
857
DI–623
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ABS & TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
DI050–03
Check for Fluid Leakage
Check for fluid leakage from actuator or hydraulic lines.
F00070
Author:
Date:
858
DI–624
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1AX–04
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Customer Problem Analysis
DI–625
5
2
Normal
Symptom Simulation
Warning Light Check
IN–21
DI–626
Remains ON
3
DTC Check
DI–626
Warning Light ON
Normal and Malfunction Code
4
DTC Chart
DI–633
6
7
Circuit Inspection
DTC Check
DI–626
DI–640
Identification of Problem
Repair
8
Warning Light Check
DI–626
Normal
Warning Light Remains OFF
Confirmation Test
END
Step
3
,
6
:
Diagnostic steps permitting the use
of the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Author:
Date:
859
DI–625
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI15Z–07
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Inspector’s
Name
Supplemental Restraint System Check Sheet
Registration No.
Customer’s Name
Registration Year
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle Brought In
/
/
km
Miles
Odometer Reading
/
Date Problem Occurred
Weather
Fine
Temperature
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
/
Other
Approx.
Starting
Vehicle Operation
Driving
Idling
[
Constant speed
Other
Acceleration
Deceleration
]
Road Conditions
Details Of Problem
Vehicle Inspection, Repair History Prior to Occurrence of Malfunction (Including Supplemental Restraint System)
Diagnosis System Inspection
SRS Warning Light
Inspection
1st Time
Remains ON
Sometimes Light Up
Does Not Light Up
2nd Time
Remains ON
Sometimes Light Up
Does Not Light Up
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code
[ Code.
]
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code
[ Code.
]
DTC Inspection
Author:
Date:
860
DI–626
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L1–01
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
(b)
SRS WARNING LIGHT CHECK
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position and
check that the SRS warning light lights up.
Check that the SRS warning light goes out after approx.
6 seconds.
HINT:
H02309
When the ignition switch is at ACC or ON and the SRS
warning light remains on or flashes, the airbag sensor assembly has detected a malfunction code.
If, after approx. 6 seconds have elapsed, the SRS warning light sometimes lights up or the SRS warning light
lights up even when the ignition switch is OFF, a short in
the SRS warning light circuit can be considered likely.
Proceed to ”SRS warning light circuit malfunction” on
page DI–790, DI–792.
2.
(a)
DLC1
E1
Tc
R13006
DTC CHECK (Using diagnosis check wire)
Present troubles codes:
Output the DTC.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position
and wait for approx. 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of the
DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
NOTICE:
Pay due attention to the terminal connecting position to
avoid a malfunction.
(b) Past troubles codes:
Output the DTC.
(1) Using service wire, connect Terminals Tc and E1 of
the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position
and wait for approx. 20 seconds.
NOTICE:
Pay due attention to the terminal connecting position to
avoid a malfunction.
Author:
Date:
861
DI–627
DIAGNOSTICS
0.25
ON
OFF
0.25
Code 11 and 31
4.0
2.5
ON
OFF
1.5
DTC 11
AT0716
AB0056
0.5
Repeat
DTC 31
H08231
Read the DTC.
Read the 2–digit DTC as indicated by the number of times
the SRS warning light blinks. As an example, the blinking
patterns, normal, 11 and 31 are shown in the illustration.
Normal code indication
The light will blink 2 times per second.
Malfunction code indication
The first blinking output indicates the first digit
of a 2–digit DTC. After a 1.5–second pause,
the second blinking output will indicate the
second digit.
If there are 2 or more codes, there will be a 2.5–second pause
between each code. After all the codes have been output, there
will be a 4.0–second pause and they will all be repeated.
HINT:
In the event of a number of trouble codes, indication will
start from the smallest numbered code.
If a DTC is not output or a DTC is output without terminal
connection, proceed to the Tc terminal circuit inspection
on page DI–796.
3.
(a)
DLC1
(b)
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester
H08398
S05331
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(c)
Normal Code
0.5
–
DLC3
H08323
DTC CHECK (Using TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC1 or
the DLC3.
Read the DTCs by following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
4.
DTC CLEARANCE (Not using service wire)
When the ignition switch is turned off, the diagnostic trouble
code is cleared.
HINT:
DTC might not be cleared by turning the ignition switch OFF.
In this case, proceed to the next step.
5.
DTC CLEARANCE (Using service wire)
(a) Connect the 2 service wires to terminals Tc and AB of
DLC1.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait for approx.
6 seconds.
Author:
Date:
862
DI–628
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Starting with the Tc terminal, ground alternately terminal
Tc and terminal AB twice each in cycles of 1.0 seconds.
Make sure that the terminals are grounded. Ensure the
terminal Tc remain grounded.
HINT:
When alternately grounding terminals Tc and AB, release
ground from one terminal and immediately ground the other terminal within an interval of 0.2 seconds.
If DTCs are not cleared, repeat the above procedure until the
codes are cleared.
Terminal
1 seconds
OFF
Tc
Tc
AB
Body
Ground
1 seconds
(± 0.5 sec.)(± 0.5 sec.)
3
1
5
OFF
AB
Body
Ground
2
4
Several
Seconds
ON
50 m sec.
OFF
50 m sec.
H02309
H01461
H02271
(d)
6.
Several seconds after doing the clearing procedure, the
SRS warning light will blink in a 50 m sec. cycle to indicate
the codes which have been cleared.
Past troubles codes:
DTC CLEARANCE
(See step 5.)
Author:
Date:
863
DI–629
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
7.
RELEASE METHOD OF AIRBAG ACTIVATION PREVENTION MECHANISM
An airbag activation prevention mechanism is built into the connector for the squib circuit of the SRS.
When release of the airbag activation prevention mechanism is
directed in the troubleshooting procedure, as shown in the illustration of the connectors on the next pages, insert paper
which is the same thickness as the male terminal, between the
terminal and the short spring.
CAUTION:
Never release the airbag activation prevention mechanism
on the steering wheel pad connector.
NOTICE:
Do not release the airbag activation prevention mechanism unless specifically directed by the troubleshooting procedure.
If the inserted paper is too thick the terminal and short
spring may be damaged, so always use paper with
the same thickness as the male terminal.
Author:
Date:
864
DI–630
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
TMC made :
8
Side Airbag Assembly (RH)
(Squib)
9
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (RH)
10
Side Airbag Sensor (RH)
11
12
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
4
2
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
1
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly (Squib)
Spiral Cable 7
5
3
Steering Wheel
Pad (Squib)
6
No.1 J/B
13
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
14
Side Airbag Sensor (LH)
15
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (LH)
16
Side Airbag Assembly (LH)
(Squib)
H08316
Author:
Date:
865
DI–631
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
TMMK made :
18
8
Side Airbag Assembly (RH)
(Squib)
9
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (RH)
10
Side Airbag Sensor (RH)
11
12
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
4
Front Passenger Airbag
Assembly (Squib)
Spiral Cable
7
2
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
5
1
3
Steering Wheel
Pad (Squib)
6
No.1 J / B
13
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
14
Side Airbag Sensor (LH)
15
17
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (LH)
16
Side Airbag Assembly (LH)
(Squib)
H08247
Author:
Date:
866
DI–632
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Airbag Sensor Assembly Connector
2
1
3
Short Spring
Short Spring
Short Spring
After Release
Before Release
Paper
Connector 5
Short Spring
7
Connector 8 16 17 18
Short Spring
Connector 4
Short Spring
After Release
Before Release
Paper
Paper
H01356
H01233
AB0130
AB0045
H02249
H00992
AB0046
H02248
H01358
Author:
Date:
867
DI–633
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1AZ–04
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table
below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit.).
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Short in D squib circuit
B0100/13
(DI–640)
Open in D squib circuit
B0101/14
(DI–645)
Short in D squib circuit (to Ground)
B0102/11
(DI–649)
Short in D squib circuit (to B+)
B0103/12
(DI–653)
B0105/53
(DI–657)
B0106/54
(DI–661)
B0107/51
(DI–664)
B0108/52
(DI–667)
TMC made:
B0110/43
(DI–670)
TMMK made:
B0110/43
(DI–674)
TMC made:
B0111/44
(DI–679)
TMMK made:
B0111/44
(DI–682)
TMC made:
B0112/41
(DI–686)
Short in P squib circuit
Open in P squib circuit
Short in P squib circuit (to Ground)
Short in P squib circuit (to B+)
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
Open in side squib (RH) circuit
Open in side squib (RH) circuit
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
(to Ground)
SRS
Warning Light
Trouble Area
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Side airbag assembly RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Side airbag assembly RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
Blink
Side airbag assembly RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Side airbag assembly RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
Blink
Side airbag assembly RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Author:
Date:
868
DI–634
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
TMMK made:
B0112/41
(DI–689)
TMC made:
B0113/42
(DI–693)
TMMK made:
B0113/42
(DI–696)
TMC made:
B0115/47
(DI–700)
TMMK made:
B0115/47
(DI–704)
TMC made:
B0116/48
(DI–709)
TMMK made:
B0116/48
(DI–712)
TMC made:
B0117/45
(DI–716)
TMMK made:
B0117/45
(DI–719)
TMC made:
B0118/46
(DI–723)
TMMK made:
B0118/46
(DI–726)
B0130/63
(DI–730)
B0131/64
(DI–734)
B0132/61
(DI–737)
B0133/62
(DI–740)
Detection Item
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SRS
Warning Light
Trouble Area
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
(to Ground)
Side airbag assembly RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
Blink
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
(to B+)
Side airbag assembly RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in side squib (RH) circuit
(to B+)
Side airbag assembly RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
Blink
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
Side airbag assembly LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Side airbag assembly LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
Blink
Side airbag assembly LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Side airbag assembly LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
Blink
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
(to Ground)
Side airbag assembly LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
(to Ground)
Side airbag assembly LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
Blink
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
(to B+)
Side airbag assembly LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
(to B+)
Side airbag assembly LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit
Seat belt pretensioner RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Seat belt pretensioner RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit
(to Ground)
Seat belt pretensioner RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit
(to B+)
Seat belt pretensioner RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in side squib (LH) circuit
Open in side squib (LH) circuit
Open in side squib (LH) circuit
Open in P/T squib (RH) circuit
Author:
Date:
869
DI–635
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SRS
Warning Light
Trouble Area
Seat belt pretensioner LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Seat belt pretensioner LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit
(to Ground)
Seat belt pretensioner LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit
(to B+)
Seat belt pretensioner LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
B1100/31
(DI–756)
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly
B1140/32
(DI–758)
Side airbag sensor assembly (RH)
malfunction
Side airbag sensor assembly (RH)
Wire harness
Blink
B1141/33
(DI–766)
Side airbag sensor assembly (LH)
malfunction
Side airbag sensor assembly (LH)
Wire harness
Blink
B1156/B1157/
15
(DI–774)
Front airbag sensor (RH) malfunction
Front airbag sensor (RH)
Wire harness
Engine room main wire harness
ON
B1158/B1159/
16
(DI–782)
Front airbag sensor (LH) malfunction
B0135/73
(DI–743)
B0136/74
(DI–747)
B0137/71
(DI–750)
B0138/72
(DI–753)
Normall
N
(DI–787)
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit
–
Open in P/T squib (LH) circuit
Front airbag sensor (LH)
Wire harness
System normal
Voltage source drop
ON
ON
OFF
–
Battery
Airbag sensor assembly
ON
HINT:
When the SRS warning light remains lit up and the DTC is the normal code, this means a voltage source
drops.
This malfunction is not stored in memory by the airbag sensor assembly and if the power source voltage returns to normal, the SRS warning light will automatically go out.
When 2 or more codes are indicated, the codes will be displayed in numeral order starting from the
lowest numbered code.
If a code not listed on the chart is displayed, the airbag sensor assembly is faulty.
Author:
Date:
870
DI–636
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B0–04
PARTS LOCATION
Steering Wheel Pad
(with Airbag)
Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Combination Meter
(Warning Light)
Side Airbag Assembly (RH)
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly (RH)
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (RH)
Spiral Cable
Side Airbag Assembly
(LH)
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (LH)
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (LH)
H08283
Author:
Date:
871
DI–637
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B1–08
TERMINALS OF ECU
C18
C17
B
A
6
5
4
B
C19
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
25 24 23 22 21 20 19
18
12
11 10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12
12
11 10
9
8
7
28 27 26
A
11 10
B
A
H01357
No.
Symbol
A
–
Electrical Connector Check Mechanism
Terminal Name
B
–
Electrical Connector Check Mechanism
C18 – 3
LA
SRS Warning Light
C18 – 5
IG2
Power Source (IGN Fuse)
C18 – 6
ACC
Power Source (CIG Fuse)
C18 – 9
SR+
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
C18 – 10
P+
Squib (Passenger)
C18 – 11
P–
Squib (Passenger)
C18 – 12
SIL
Diagnosis
C18 – 13
D–
Squib (Driver)
C18 – 14
D+
Squib (Driver)
C18 – 15
SL+
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
C18 – 19
Tc
C18 – 20
SR–
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
C18 – 26
SL–
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
C18 – 27
E1
Ground
C18 – 28
E2
Ground
C17 – 1
PL–
Squib (Seat Belt Pretensioner, LH)
C17 – 2
PL+
Squib (Seat Belt Pretensioner, LH)
C17 – 5
SFL+
Squib (Side, LH)
C17 – 6
SFL–
Squib (Side, LH)
C17 – 7
VUPL
Side Airbag Sensor (LH)
C17 – 9
SSL+
Side Airbag Sensor (LH)
C17 – 10
FSL
Side Airbag Sensor (LH)
C17 – 12
ESL
Side Airbag Sensor (LH)
Diagnosis
Author:
Date:
872
DI–638
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
No.
Symbol
Terminal Name
C19 – 1
SFR–
Squib (Side, RH)
C19 – 2
SFR+
Squib (Side, RH)
C19 – 5
PR+
Squib (Pretensioner, RH)
C19 – 6
PR–
Squib (Pretensioner, RH)
C19 – 7
ESR
Side Airbag Sensor (RH)
C19 – 9
FSR
Side Airbag Sensor (RH)
C19 – 10
SSR+
Side Airbag Sensor (RH)
C19 – 12
VUPR
Side Airbag Sensor (RH)
Author:
Date:
873
DI–639
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI164–18
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Proceed with troubleshooting of each circuit in the table below.
Symptom
With the ignition switch in ACC or ON position, the SRS warning
light sometimes lights up after approx. 6 seconds have elapsed.
SRS warning light is always lit up even when ignition switch is in
the LOCK position.
With the ignition switch in ACC or ON position, the SRS warning
light does not light up.
Suspect Area
See page
SRS warning light circuit
(Al
(Always
lights
li ht up when
h ignition
i iti switch
it h is
i in
i LOCK posii
tion.)
DI 790
DI–790
SRS warning light circuit
(Does not light up when ignition switch is turned to ACC or
ON.)
DI–792
Tc terminal circuit
DI–796
DTC is not displayed.
SRS warning light is always lit up at the time of DTC check procedure.
DTC is displayed without Tc and E1 terminal connection.
Author:
Date:
874
DI–640
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI18Q–09
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
B0100/13
Short in D Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and steering wheel pad.
It causes the airbag to deploy when the airbag deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0100/13 is recorded when a short is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0100/13
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between D+ wire harness and D– wire harness of squib
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Steering wheel pad (D squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
D Squib
1
Y–B
2
Y
14
C18 D+
13
C18 D–
Spiral
Cable
H01451
Author:
Date:
875
DI–641
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check D squib circuit.
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the spiral cable.
(See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
←→
D–
(–)
H01001
R14286
D+
(+)
H01134
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
876
DI–642
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
ACC
→←
ON
or
DTC B0100/13
DLC1
E1
H01002
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 FI1390
Tc
H07478
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0100/13 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0100/13 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
877
DI–643
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check D squib.
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
ACC
ON
or
DTC B0100/13
DLC1
E1
Tc
H01003
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 FI1390
H01136
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0100/13 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0100/13 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace steering wheel pad.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
878
DI–644
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
←→
D–
(–)
D+
(+)
H01000
R14286
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the connector between the airbag sensor assembly and the spiral cable.
(b) Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of
the spiral cable connector on the airbag sensor assembly
side. (See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
H01137
NG
Repair or replace spiral cable.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
←→
D–
(–)
H01004
R14286
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the spiral cable. (See page
DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the airbag
sensor assembly and the spiral cable, measure the resistance
between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
D+
(+)
H01138
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
879
DI–645
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI18R–16
DTC
B0101/14
Open in D Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and steering wheel pad.
It causes the airbag to deploy when the airbag deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0101/14 is recorded when an open is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B0101/14
Trouble Area
Open circuit in D+ wire harness or D– wire harness of
squib
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Steering wheel pad (D squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–640.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check D squib circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
←→
D–
(–)
H01001
R14286
D+
(+)
H01139
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
880
DI–646
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
D–
D+
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01002 AB0069
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 W02044
DTC B0101/14
Tc
H01140
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– of the connector
(on the spiral cable side) between the spiral cable and the
steering wheel pad.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0101/14 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0101/14 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
881
DI–647
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check D squib.
D Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01003
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 W02044
DTC B0101/14
Tc
H01141
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0101/14 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0101/14 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace steering wheel pad.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
882
DI–648
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check spiral cable.
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
←→
D–
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
D+
H01000
R14286
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector between the airbag sensor assembly
and the spiral cable.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
H01142
NG
Repair or replace spiral cable.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
D–
(–)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the airbag
sensor assembly and the spiral cable, measure the resistance
between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
D+
(+)
NG
H01004
R14286
H01143
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
883
DI–649
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L2–01
DTC
B0102/11
Short in D Squib Circuit (to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and steering wheel pad.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0102/11 is recorded when a ground short is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0102/11
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib wire harness (to ground)
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Steering wheel pad (D squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–640.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check D squib circuit.
Spiral
Cable
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
D Squib
D+
H01001
R14301
H01126
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
884
DI–650
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
D–
D+
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0102/11
Tc
H01002
W01933 AB0069
AB0118 AB0118
R13006 W02042
H01127
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– of the connector
(on the spiral cable side) between the spiral cable and the
steering wheel pad.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0102/11 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0102/11 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
885
DI–651
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check D squib.
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01003
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 W02042
DTC B0102/11
Tc
H01128
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0102/11 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0102/11 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace steering wheel pad.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
886
DI–652
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
←→
D+
(–)
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector between the airbag sensor assembly
and the spiral cable.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the steering wheel pad and the spiral cable, measure the resistance between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
H01000
R14301
H01129
NG
Repair or replace spiral cable.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
D+
(–)
H01004
R14301
(+)
H06304
NG
Repair or replace harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
887
DI–653
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L3–01
DTC
B0103/12
Short in D Squib Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and steering wheel pad.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0103/12 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib wire harness (to B+)
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0103/12
Steering wheel pad (D squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–640.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check D squib circuit.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the
spiral cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the voltage between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
D+
(–)
AB0119
H01001
R14288
(+)
H04530
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
888
DI–654
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
D+
D–
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DTC B0103/12
DLC1
E1
–
Tc
H01002 AB0069
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 W02043
H01131
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– of the connector
(on the spiral cable side) between the spiral cable and the
steering wheel pad.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0103/12 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0103/12 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
889
DI–655
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check D squib.
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
ACC
ON
or
DTC B0103/12
DLC1
E1
–
Tc
H01003
AB0118 AB0019
R13006 W02043
H01132
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0103/12 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0103/12 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace steering wheel pad.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
890
DI–656
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check spiral cable.
Spiral
Cable
←→
D Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
D+
(–)
(+)
H01000
AB0119
R14288
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect the connector between the airbag sensor assembly and the spiral cable.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the
spiral cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the voltage between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
H01133
NG
Repair or replace spiral cable.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the
spiral cable and airbag sensor assembly, measure the
voltage between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
D+
(–)
AB0119
H01004
R14288
(+)
NG
Repair or replace harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
H08261
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
891
DI–657
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B6–12
DTC
B0105/53
Short in P Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag assembly.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0105/53 is recorded when a short is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0105/53
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib wire harness
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Front passenger airbag assembly (P squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
P Squib
1
Y–R
2
Y–G
10
C18 P+
11
C18 P–
H01454
Author:
Date:
892
DI–658
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P squib circuit.
PREPARATION:
Release airbag activation prevention mechanism of the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front
passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly.
(See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front passenger airbag assembly
side) between the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between P+ and
P–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P–
(–)
R14286
H02142
P+
(+)
H02251
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between front passenger airbag assembly and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
893
DI–659
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01023
AB0118
R13006
–
AB0119
H01077
DTC B0105/53
Tc
H07479
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0105/53 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0105/53 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
894
DI–660
DIAGNOSTICS
4
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P squib.
P Squib
H01024
AB0118
R13006
–
DTC B0105/53
Tc
AB0119
H01077
H01202
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0105/53 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0105/53 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
895
DI–661
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B7–17
DTC
B0106/54
Open in P Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag assembly.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0106/54 is recorded when an open is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0106/54
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in P+ wire harness or P– wire harness of
squib
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Front passenger airbag assembly (P squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–657.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P squib circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front passenger airbag assembly
side) between the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between P+ and
P–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P–
(–)
R14286
H02142
P+
(+)
NG
H02251
Repair or replace harness or connector between front passenger airbag assembly and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
896
DI–662
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
P+
P–
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0106/54
Tc
H01023
H02144
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01078
H02253
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– of the connector
(on the front passenger airbag assembly side) between
the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0106/54 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0106/54 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
897
DI–663
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P squib.
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01024
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01078
DTC B0106/54
Tc
H01205
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0106/54 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0106/54 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
898
DI–664
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B8–11
DTC
B0107/51
Short in P Squib Circuit (to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag assembly.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0107/51 is recorded when ground short is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0107/51
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib wire harness (to ground)
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Front passenger airbag assembly (P squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–657.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P squib circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front passenger airbag assembly
side) between the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between P+ and
body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P+
(–)
(+)
NG
H01227
H02145
H02254
Repair or replace harness or connector between front passenger airbag assembly and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
899
DI–665
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
P+
P–
or
DTC B0107/51
DLC1
E1 Tc
H01023 H02144
AB0118 AB0118
R13006 H01075
H02255
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– of the connector
(on the front passenger airbag assembly side) between
the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0107/51 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0107/51 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
900
DI–666
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P squib.
P Squib
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0107/51
Tc
H01024
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01075
H01196
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See stpe 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0107/51 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0107/51 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
901
DI–667
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B9–16
DTC
B0108/52
Short in P Squib Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag assembly.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0108/52 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0108/52
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib wire harness (to B+)
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Front passenger airbag assembly (P squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–657.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P squib circuit.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the front passenger airbag assembly side) between the front passenger airbag assembly
and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between the P+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P Squib
P+
(–)
AB0119
H01022
H02146
(+)
H08262
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between front passenger airbag assembly and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
902
DI–668
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
P+
P–
or
DTC B0108/52
DLC1
E1
Tc
H01023 H02144
AB0118 AB0118
R13006 H01076
H02257
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– of the connector
(on the front passenger airbag assembly side) between
the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0108/52 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0108/52 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
903
DI–669
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P squib.
P Squib
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0108/52
Tc
H01024
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01076
H01199
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0108/52 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0108/52 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
904
DI–670
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI16G–08
DTC
B0110/43
Short in Side Squib (RH) Circuit
(TMC Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0110/43 is recorded when a short is detected in the side squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0110/43
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between SFR+ wire harness and SFR– wire
harness of squib
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Side Squib (RH)
1
Y–R
2
C19 SFR+
2
Y–G
1
C19 SFR–
H01454
Author:
Date:
905
DI–671
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (RH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
SFR–
(–)
H01019
W03859
SFR+
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the side airbag assembly (RH).
(See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFR+ and SFR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
H01180
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
906
DI–672
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01020
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01069
DTC B0110/43
Tc
H07481
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0110/43 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0110/43 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
907
DI–673
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01069
DTC B0110/43
Tc
H01179
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 second.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0110/43 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0110/43 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
908
DI–674
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1KY–02
DTC
B0110/43
Short in Side Squib (RH) Circuit
(TMMK Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0110/43 is recorded when a short is detected in the side squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0110/43
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between SFR+ wire harness and SFR– wire
harness of squib
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Side Squib (RH)
Y–R
1
BW1
Y–R
2
C19 SFR+
Y–G
2
BW1
Y–G
1
C19 SFR–
1
2
H04507
Author:
Date:
909
DI–675
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (RH) circuit.
Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SFR–
H02272
W03859
SFR+
PREPARATION:
Release airbag activation prevention mechanism of the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the airbag
sensor assembly and the side airbag assembly (RH).
(See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFR+ and SFR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
H02315
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
910
DI–676
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
H08250
W03860
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01069
DTC B0110/43
H08249
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0110/43 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0110/43 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
911
DI–677
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H02274
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01069
DTC B0110/43
Tc
H02317
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 second.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0110/43 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0110/43 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (RH).
OK
For the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
912
DI–678
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check sub wire harness.
Sub Wire Harness
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH) ← →
SFR–
(–)
SFR+
(+)
H02275
W03859
H03247
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect sub wire harness connector on the airbag
sensor assembly side.
(b) Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of
the sub wire harness connector on the airbag sensor assembly side. (See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
side airbag assembly and the sub wire harness, measure the
resistance between SFR+ and SFR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Repair or replace sub wire harness.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness.
Sub Wire Harness
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the airbag sensor assembly connector. (See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness, measure the resistance between SFR+ and SFR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH) ← →
SFR–
(–)
H02276
W03859
SFR+
(+)
NG
H03248
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire
harness.
OK
For the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
913
DI–679
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BA–03
DTC
B0111/44
Open in Side Squib (RH) Circuit
(TMC Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0111/44 is recorded when an open is detected in the side squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in SFR+ wire harness or SFR– wire harness
of squib
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0111/44
Side airbag assembly (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–670.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (RH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
SFR–
(–)
H01019
W03859
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFR+ and SFR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
SFR+
(+)
NG
H01180
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
914
DI–680
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
SFR–
ON
SFR+
or
DLC1
H01020
W03860
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01070
E1
DTC B0111/44
Tc
H01181
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFR+ and SFR– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0111/44 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0111/44 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
915
DI–681
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01070
DTC B0111/44
Tc
H01182
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0111/44 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0111/44 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
916
DI–682
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1L0–02
DTC
B0111/44
Open in Side Squib (RH) Circuit
(TMMK Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0111/44 is recorded when an open is detected in the side squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0111/44
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in SFR+ wire harness or SFR– wire harness
of squib
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–674.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (RH) circuit.
Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SFR–
H02272
W03859
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFR+ and SFR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
SFR+
H02315
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
917
DI–683
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
SFR–
ON
SFR+
or
DLC1
H02273
W03860
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01070
E1
DTC B0111/44
Tc
H03249
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFR+ and SFR– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0111/44 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0111/44 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
918
DI–684
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H02274
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01070
DTC B0111/44
Tc
H03250
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0111/44 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0111/44 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
919
DI–685
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check sub wire harness.
Sub Wire Harness
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
←→
Squib (RH)
SFR–
(–)
SFR+
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the sub wire harness connector on the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
side airbag assembly and the sub wire harness, measure the
resistance between SFR+ and SFR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
(+)
H02275
W03859
H03247
NG
Repair or replace sub wire harness.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness.
Sub Wire Harness
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the airbag sensor assembly and the sub wire harness,
measure the resistance SFR+ and SFR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH) ← →
SFR–
(–)
H02276
W03859
SFR+
(+)
NG
H03248
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire
harness.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
920
DI–686
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BB–03
DTC
B0112/41
Short in Side Squib (RH) Circuit
(to Ground) (TMC Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0112/41 is recorded when ground short is detected in the side squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0112/41
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (RH) wire harness (to ground)
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–670.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (RH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFR+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
SFR+
NG
(–)
H01019
H02118
(+)
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
H02126
OK
Author:
Date:
921
DI–687
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
SFR–
ON
SFR+
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0112/41
Tc
H01020
W03860
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01067
H01172
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFR+ and SFR– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0112/41 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0112/41 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
922
DI–688
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0112/41
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01067
Tc
H01173
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0112/41 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0112/41 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
923
DI–689
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L4–01
DTC
B0112/41
Short in Side Squib (RH) Circuit
(to Ground) (TMMK Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0112/41 is recorded when ground short is detected in the side squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0112/41
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (RH) wire harness (to ground)
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–674.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (RH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFR+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
SFR+
(–)
H02272
H02118
(+)
H03251
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
924
DI–690
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
SFR–
ON
SFR+
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0112/41
Tc
H02273
W03860
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01067
H03252
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFR+ and SFR– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0112/41 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0112/41 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
925
DI–691
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0112/41
E1
H02274
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01067
Tc
H03253
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0112/41 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0112/41 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
926
DI–692
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check sub wire harness.
Sub Wire Harness
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH) ← →
SFR+
(–)
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the sub wire harness connector on the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
side airbag assembly and the sub wire harness, measure the
resistance between SFR+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1MΩ or Higher
(+)
H02275
H02118
H03254
NG
Repair or replace sub wire harness.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness.
Sub Wire Harness
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
sub wire harness and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the
resistance between SFR+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
SFR+
(–)
H02276
H02118
(+)
NG
H08251
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire
harness.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
927
DI–693
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BC–03
DTC
B0113/42
Short in Side Squib (RH) Circuit (to B+)
(TMC Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0113/42 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the side squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (RH) wire harness (to B+)
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0113/42
Side airbag assembly (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–670.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–626)
2
Check side squib (RH) circuit.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side)
between the side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag
sensor assembly, measure the voltage between SFR+
and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
SFR+
AB0119
H01019
H02119
(–)
(+)
H08263
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
928
DI–694
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
SFR+
SFR–
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0113/42
Tc
H01020
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01068
H01175
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFR+ and SFR– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0113/42 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0113/42 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
929
DI–695
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (RH).
Squib (RH)
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01068
DTC B0113/42
Tc
H01176
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0113/42 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0113/42 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
930
DI–696
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L5–01
DTC
B0113/42
Short in Side Squib (RH) Circuit (to B+)
(TMMK Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0113/42 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the side squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (RH) wire harness (to B+)
Side squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0113/42
Side airbag assembly (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–674.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (RH) circuit.
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side)
between the side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag
sensor assembly, measure the voltage between the
SFR+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
SFR+
(–)
AB0119
H02272
H02119
(+)
H08264
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
931
DI–697
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
SFR+
SFR–
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0113/42
Tc
H02273
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01068
H03256
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFR+ and SFR– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0113/42 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0113/42 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
932
DI–698
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H02274
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01068
DTC B0113/42
Tc
H03257
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0113/42 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0113/42 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
933
DI–699
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check sub wire harness.
ON
Sub wire Harness
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
SFR+
(–)
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the sub wire harness connector on the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between
the side airbag assembly and the sub wire harness, measure the voltage between SFR+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
(+)
AB0119
H02275
H02119
H08260
NG
Repair or replace sub wire harness.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness.
ON
Sub Wire Harness
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (RH)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between
the sub wire harness and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the voltage between SFR+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
SFR+
(–)
AB0119
H02276
H02119
(+)
NG
H08252
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire
harness.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
934
DI–700
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI16K–08
DTC
B0115/47
Short in Side Squib (LH) Circuit
(TMC Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0115/47 is recorded when a short is detected in the side squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0115/47
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between SFL+ wire harness and SFL– wire
harness of squib
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Side Squib (LH)
1
Y–R
5
C17 SFL+
2
Y–G
6
C17 SFL–
H01454
Author:
Date:
935
DI–701
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (LH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (LH)
SFL–
(–)
H01019
W03859
SFL+
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the side airbag assembly (LH).
(See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFL+ and SFL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
H01191
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
936
DI–702
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (LH)
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0115/47
E1 Tc
H01017
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01073
H07483
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0115/47 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0115/47 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
937
DI–703
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (LH).
Squib (LH)
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01073
DTC B0115/47
Tc
H01190
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 second.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0115/47 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0115/47 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
938
DI–704
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1L6–02
DTC
B0115/47
Short in Side Squib (LH) Circuit
(TMMK Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0115/47 is recorded when a short is detected in the side squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0115/47
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between SFL+ wire harness and SFL– wire
harness of squib
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Side Squib (LH)
Y–R
1
Y–G
2
BV1
BV1
Y–R
5
C17 SFL+
Y–G
6
C17 SFL–
H04507
Author:
Date:
939
DI–705
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (LH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (LH)
SFL–
(–)
H02277
W03859
SFL+
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the side airbag assembly (LH).
(See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFL+ and SFL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
H03259
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
940
DI–706
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (LH)
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0115/47
E1 Tc
H08254
W03860
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01073
H08253
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0115/47 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0115/47 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
941
DI–707
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (LH).
Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H02279
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01073
DTC B0115/47
Tc
H03261
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 second.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0115/47 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0115/47 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
942
DI–708
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check sub wire harness.
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
←→
Sub Wire Harness
SFL–
(–)
SFL+
(+)
H02280
W03859
H03262
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect sub wire harness connector on the airbag
sensor assembly side.
(b) Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of
the sub wire harness connector on the airbag sensor assembly side. (See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
side airbag assembly and the sub wire harness, measure the
resistance between SFL+ and SFL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Repair or replace sub wire harness.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness.
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the airbag sensor assembly connector. (See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness, measure the resistance between SFL+ and SFL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Sub Wire Harness
SFL–
(–)
H02281
W03859
SFL+
NG
(+)
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire
harness.
H03263
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
943
DI–709
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BD–03
DTC
B0116/48
Open in Side Squib (LH) Circuit
(TMC Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0116/48 is recorded when an open is detected in the side squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in SFL+ wire harness or SFL– wire harness
of squib
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0116/48
Side airbag assembly (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–700.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (LH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFL+ and SFL–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (LH)
SFL–
SFL+
NG
(–)
H01019
W03859
(+)
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
H01191
OK
Author:
Date:
944
DI–710
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
SFL–
ON
SFL+
or
DLC1
DTC B0116/48
E1 Tc
H01017
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01074
H01192
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFL+ and SFL– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0116/48 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0116/48 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
945
DI–711
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (LH).
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01074
DTC B0116/48
Tc
H01193
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0116/48 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0116/48 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
946
DI–712
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1L8–02
DTC
B0116/48
Open in Side Squib (LH) Circuit
(TMMK Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0116/48 is recorded when an open short is detected in the side squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in SFL+ wire harness or SFL– wire harness
of squib
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0116/48
Side airbag assembly (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–704.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (LH) circuit.
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SFL–
(–)
H02277
W03859
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFL+ and SFL–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
SFL+
(+)
H03259
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
947
DI–713
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
SFL–
ON
SFL+
or
DLC1
DTC B0116/48
E1 Tc
H02278
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01074
H03264
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFL+ and SFL– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0116/48 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0116/48 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
948
DI–714
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (LH).
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H02279
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01074
DTC B0116/48
Tc
H03265
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0116/48 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0116/48 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
949
DI–715
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check sub wire harness.
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Sub Wire harness
SFL–
(–)
SFL+
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the sub wire harness connector on the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
side airbag assembly and the sub wire harness, measure the
resistance between SFL+ and SFL–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
(+)
H02280
W03859
H03266
NG
Repair or replace sub wire harness.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the airbag sensor assembly and the sub wire harness,
measure the resistance between SFL+ and SFL–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Sub Wire harness
SFL–
SFL+
NG
(–)
H02281
W03859
(+)
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire
harness.
H03267
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
950
DI–716
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BE–03
DTC
B0117/45
Short in Side Squib (LH) Circuit
(to Ground) (TMC Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0117/45 is recorded when ground short is detected in the side squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0117/45
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (LH) wire harness (to ground)
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–700.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (LH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFL+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SFL+
NG
(–)
H01016
H02118
(+)
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
H02128
OK
Author:
Date:
951
DI–717
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
SFL+
SFL–
or
DLC1
E1
H01017
W03860
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01071
DTC B0117/45
Tc
H01184
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFL+ and SFL– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0117/45 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0117/45 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
952
DI–718
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (LH).
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01071
DTC B0117/45
Tc
H01185
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0117/45 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0117/45 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
953
DI–719
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L6–01
DTC
B0117/45
Short in Side Squib (LH) Circuit
(to Ground) (TMMK Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0117/45 is recorded when a ground short is detected in the side squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B0117/45
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (LH) wire harness (to ground)
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–704.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (LH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between
the side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between SFL+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SFL+
NG
(–)
H02277
H02118
(+)
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
H03268
OK
Author:
Date:
954
DI–720
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SFL–
SFL+
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H02278
W03860
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01071
DTC B0117/45
Tc
H03269
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFL+ and SFL– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0117/45 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0117/45 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
955
DI–721
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (LH).
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H02279
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01071
DTC B0117/45
Tc
H03270
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0117/45 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0117/45 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
956
DI–722
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check sub wire harness.
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Sub Wire Harness
SFL+
(–)
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the sub wire harness connector on the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
side airbag assembly and the sub wire harness, measure the
resistance between SFL+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
H02280
H02118
H03271
NG
Repair or replace sub wire harness.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness, measure the resistance between SFL+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Sub Wire Harness
SFL+
(–)
H02281
H02118
(+)
NG
H08255
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire
harness.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
957
DI–723
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BF–03
DTC
B0118/46
Short in Side Squib (LH) Circuit (to B+)
(TMC Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0118/46 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the side squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (LH) wire harness (to B+)
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0118/46
Side airbag assembly (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–700.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (LH) circuit.
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (LH)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between SFL+ and
body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
SFL+
(–)
AB0119
H01016
H02119
(+)
NG
H08265
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag assembly (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
958
DI–724
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
SFL+
SFL–
or
DLC1
H01017
DTC B0118/46
E1 Tc
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01072
H01187
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFL+ and SFL– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0118/46 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0118/46 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
959
DI–725
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (LH).
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01072
DTC B0118/46
Tc
H01234
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0118/46 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0118/46 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
960
DI–726
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L7–01
DTC
B0118/46
Short in Side Squib (LH) Circuit (to B+)
(TMMK Made)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and side airbag assembly (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0118/46 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the side squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0118/46
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in side squib (LH) wire harness (to B+)
Side squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Side airbag assembly (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Sub wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–704.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check side squib (LH) circuit.
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (LH)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between SFL+ and
body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
SFL+
(–)
AB0119
H02277
H02119
(+)
H08266
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
961
DI–727
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
SFL+
SFL–
or
DLC1
H02278
DTC B0118/46
E1 Tc
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01072
H03273
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SFL+ and SFL– of the connector (on the side airbag assembly side) between the
side airbag assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0118/46 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0118/46 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
962
DI–728
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side squib (LH).
Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H02279
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01072
DTC B0118/46
Tc
H03274
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag assembly (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0118/46 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0118/46 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
963
DI–729
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check sub wire harness.
Sub Wire Harness
Squib (LH)
←→
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
SFL+
(–)
H02280
AB0119
H02119
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the sub wire harness connector on the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between
the side airbag assembly and the sub wire harness, measure the resistance between SFL+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
(+)
H08267
NG
Repair or replace sub wire harness.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness.
ON
Sub Wire Harness
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Squib (LH)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the sub wire harness side) between
the airbag sensor assembly and sub wire harness, measure the voltage between SFL and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
SFL+
(–)
AB0119
H02281
H02119
(+)
NG
H08256
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and sub wire
harness.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
964
DI–730
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI16S–17
DTC
B0130/63
Short in P/T Squib (RH) Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0130/63 is recorded when a short is detected in the P/T squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0130/63
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between PR+ wire harness and PR– wire
harness of squib
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Seat belt pretensioner (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
1
Y–B
5
C19 PR+
2
Y
6
C19 PR–
H01454
Author:
Date:
965
DI–731
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P/T squib (RH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
PR+
(+)
H01019
H02141
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the seat belt pretensioner (RH).
(See page DI–626).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between PR+ and PR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
PR–
(–)
H02203
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
966
DI–732
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0130/63
E1
H01020
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01082
Tc
H07485
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0130/63 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0130/63 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
967
DI–733
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (RH).
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0130/63
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01082
Tc
H01214
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 second.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0130/63 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0130/63 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
968
DI–734
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BG–13
DTC
B0131/64
Open in P/T Squib (RH) Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib circuit (RH) consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0131/64 is recorded when an open is detected in the P/T squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0131/64
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in PR+ wire harness or PR– wire harness of
squib
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Seat belt pretensioner (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–730.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P/T squib (RH) circuit.
P/T Squib (RH)
PR+
(+)
H01019
H02141
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between PR+ and PR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
PR–
(–)
H02205
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
969
DI–735
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
PR+
PR–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01020
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01083
DTC B0131/64
Tc
H02206
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PR+ and PR– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the
seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0131/64 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0131/64 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
970
DI–736
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (RH).
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01083
DTC B0131/64
Tc
H01217
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0131/64 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0131/64 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
971
DI–737
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BH–10
DTC
B0132/61
Short in P/T Squib (RH) Circuit
(to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0132/61 is recorded when a ground short is detected in the P/T squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P/T squib (RH) wire harness (to ground)
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0132/61
Seat belt pretensioner (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–730.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P/T squib (RH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between PR+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
PR+
(–)
(+)
NG
H01019
H08392
H08393
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
972
DI–738
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
PR+
PR–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01020
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01079
DTC B0132/61
Tc
H02208
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PR+ and PR– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the
seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0132/61 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0132/61 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
973
DI–739
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (RH).
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01079
DTC B0132/61
Tc
H01208
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0132/61 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0132/61 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
974
DI–740
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BI–13
DTC
B0133/62
Short in P/T Squib (RH) Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0133/62 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the P/T squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in seat belt pretensioner (RH) wire harness
(to B+)
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0133/62
Seat belt pretensioner (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–730.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P/T squib (RH) circuit.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between PR+ and
body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
PR+
(–)
H01019
AB0119
H08394
(+)
H08268
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
975
DI–741
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
PR+
PR–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
–
H01020
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01081
DTC B0133/62
Tc
H02210
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PR+ and PR– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the
seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0133/62 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0133/62 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
976
DI–742
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01081
DTC B0133/62
Tc
H01211
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0133/62 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0133/62 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
977
DI–743
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI16W–17
DTC
B0135/73
Short in P/T Squib (LH) Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0135/73 is recorded when a short is detected in the P/T squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B0135/73
Short circuit between PL+ wire harness and PL– wire harness of squib
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Seat belt pretensioner (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
1
Y–B (*1)
L–B (*2)
2
Y
2
C17 PL+
1
C17 PL–
*1: TMC Made
*2: TMMK Made
H01454
Author:
Date:
978
DI–744
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P/T squib (LH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
PL+
(+)
H01016
H02141
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the seat belt pretensioner (LH).
(See page DI–626)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between PL+ and PL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
PL–
(–)
H02211
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
979
DI–745
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01017
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01086
DTC B0135/73
Tc
H07487
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0135/73 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
980
DI–746
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (LH).
→←
P/T Squib (LH)
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01086
DTC B0135/73
Tc
H01229
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 second.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0135/73 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
981
DI–747
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BJ–14
DTC
B0136/74
Open in P/T Squib (LH) Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib circuit (LH) consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0136/74 is recorded when an open is detected in the P/T squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in PL+ wire harness or PL– wire harness of
squib
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0136/74
Seat belt pretensioner (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–743.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P/T squib (LH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between PL+ and PL–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
PL+
PL–
NG
(+)
H01016
H02141
(–)
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
H02213
OK
Author:
Date:
982
DI–748
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
PL+
PL–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0136/74
E1
H01017
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01087
Tc
H02214
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PL+ and PL– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat
belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0136/74 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0136/74 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
983
DI–749
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (LH).
P/T Squib (LH)
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
DTC B0136/74
Tc
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01087
H01232
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0136/74 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0136/74 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
984
DI–750
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BK–10
DTC
B0137/71
Short in P/T Squib (LH) Circuit
(to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0137/71 is recorded when a ground short is detected in the P/T squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P/T squib (LH) wire harness (to ground)
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0137/71
Seat belt pretensioner (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–743.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P/T squib (LH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between PL+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
P/T Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
(–)
PL+
(+)
NG
H01016
H08392
H08396
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
985
DI–751
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
P/T Squib (LH)
PL+
PL–
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01017
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01084
DTC B0137/71
Tc
H02216
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PL+ and PL– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat
belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0137/71 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0137/71 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
986
DI–752
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (LH).
→←
P/T Squib (LH)
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0137/71
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01084
Tc
H01220
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0137/71 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0137/71 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
987
DI–753
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BL–14
DTC
B0138/72
Short in P/T Squib (LH) Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B0138/72 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the P/T squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in seat belt pretensioner (LH) wire harness
(to B+)
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0138/72
Seat belt pretensioner (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–743.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check P/T squib (LH) circuit.
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
(–)
AB0119
H01016
H08394
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between PL+ and
body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
PL+
(+)
NG
H08269
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
988
DI–754
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
PL+
PL–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01017
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01085
DTC B0138/72
Tc
H02217
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PL+ and PL– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat
belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0138/72 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0138/72 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
989
DI–755
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (LH).
P/T Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0138/72
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01085
Tc
H01222
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B0138/72 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0138/72 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
Author:
Date:
990
DI–756
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BM–18
DTC
B1100/31
Airbag Sensor Assembly Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag sensor assembly consists of a airbag sensor, safing sensor, drive circuit, diagnosis circuit and
ignition control, etc.
It receives signals from the airbag sensor, judges whether or not the SRS must be activated, and detects
diagnosis system malfunction.
DTC B1100/31 is recorded when occurrence of a malfunction in the airbag sensor assembly is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B1100/31
Airbag sensor assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
When a malfunction code other than code B1100/31 is displayed at the same time, first repair the malfunction
indicated by the malfunction code other than code B1100/31.
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check voltage at IG2 and ACC of airbag sensor assembly.
ON
Airbag Sensor Assembly
ACC
(–)
AB0119
H01298
IG2
(+)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) Measure the voltage between body ground and terminals
each of IG2 and ACC of the airbag sensor assembly connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
H01299
NG
Check that an abnormality occurs on the battery
and charging system.
OK
Author:
Date:
991
DI–757
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Is DTC B1100/31 output again?
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 FI1394
DTC B1100/31
Tc
H00022
PREPARATION:
Clear DTC.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Repeat operation in step (a) and (b) at least 5 times.
(d) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1100/31 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NO
Using simulation method, reproduce malfunction symptoms. (See page IN–21)
YES
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
Author:
Date:
992
DI–758
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L8–01
DTC
B1140/32
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly (RH)
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side airbag sensor assembly (RH) consists of the safing sensor, diagnosis circuit and lateral deceleration sensor, etc.
It receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, judges whether or not the SRS must be activated,
and diagnosis system malfunction.
DTC B1140/32 is recorded when occurrence of a malfunction in the side airbag sensor assembly (RH) is
detected.
DTC No.
B1140/32
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Side airbag sensor assembly (RH)
Wire harness
Airbag sensor assembly
Side airbag sensor assembly (RH) malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Side Aribag Sensor Assembly (RH)
4
GR
7
C19 ESR
3
LG
9
C19 FSR
2
L–Y
10
C19 SSR+
1
P
12
C19 VUPR
ESR
FSR
SSR+
VUPR
Airbag Sensor Assembly
H01450
Author:
Date:
993
DI–759
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Is DTC B1140/32 out put?
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
DTC B1140/32
Tc
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H09528
H09527
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1140/32 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
YES
The malfunctioning part can now be considered
normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation
method to check.
NO
2
Is connector of side airbag sensor assembly (RH) properly connected?
3
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on DI–787)
Author:
Date:
994
DI–760
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness.
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (RH)
←→
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
SSR+
ESR
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the side airbag sensor assembly (RH) connector.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SSR+ and ESR of the connector (on the side airbag sensor assembly side) between
the side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and airbag sensor
assembly.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and the airbag
sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SSR+ and
ESR.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
(+)
(–)
H01015
H01058 H01036
SSR+
ESR
H01160
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and
airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
995
DI–761
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness.
PREPARATION:
Using a service wire, connect VUPR and FSR of the connector
(on the side airbag sensor assembly side) between the side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and airbag sensor assembly.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and the airbag
sensor assembly, measure the resistance between VUPR and
FSR.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
VUPR
FSR
VUPR
FSR
(+)
(–)
H01015
H01059
H01037
H01161
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and
airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
996
DI–762
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness (to ground).
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (RH)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and the airbag
sensor assembly, measure the resistance between body
ground and each of SSR+, VUPR and FSR.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor Assembly
VUPR
FSR
(+)
(–)
H01013
H01038
SSR+
H01162
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and
airbag sensor assembly.
OK
7
Check wire harness (to B+).
ON
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor Assembly
SSR+
AB0119
H01013
H01039
(–)
VUPR
(+)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side)
between the side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and the
airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between
the body ground and each of SSR+, VUPR, ESR and
FSR.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
FSR
ESR
H08270
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag sensor assembly (RH) and
airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
997
DI–763
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Is DTC B1140/32 out put again?
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01012
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01065
DTC B1140/32
Tc
H01164
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the side airbag sensor assembly (RH).
(b) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B1140/32 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1140/32 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Go to step 9.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
998
DI–764
DIAGNOSTICS
9
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01012
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01065
DTC B1140/32
Tc
H01164
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the side airbag sensor (RH) from the connector and connect the side airbag sensor (LH) to the connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B1140/32 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1140/32 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
999
DI–765
DIAGNOSTICS
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side airbag sensor assembly (RH).
→←
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (RH)
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B1141/33
Tc
H01007
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01066
H01170
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag sensor (RH) to the connector that
the side airbag sensor (LH) was connected to.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B1141/33 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1141/33 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag sensor assembly (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
1000
DI–766
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L9–01
DTC
B1141/33
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly (LH)
Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The side airbag sensor assembly (LH) consists of the safing sensor, diagnosis circuit and lateral deceleration
sensor, etc.
It receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor, judges whether or not the SRS must be activated,
and diagnosis system malfunction.
DTC B1141/33 is recorded when occurrence of a malfunction in the side airbag sensor assembly (LH) is
detected.
DTC No.
B1141/33
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Side airbag sensor assembly (LH) malfunction
Side airbag sensor assembly (LH)
Wire harness
Airbag sensor assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly (LH)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
4
GR–L
12
C17 ESL
3
LG–B
10
C17 FSL
2
L–W
9
C17 SSL+
1
P–L
7
C17 VUPL
ESL
FSL
SSL+
VUPL
H01450
Author:
Date:
1001
DI–767
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Is DTC B1141/33 out put?
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B1141/33
E1
Tc
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H09530
H09529
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1141/33 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
YES
The malfunctioning part can now be considered
normal. To make sure of this, use the simulation
method to check.
NO
2
Is connector of side airbag sensor assembly (LH) properly connected?
3
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
Author:
Date:
1002
DI–768
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness.
←→
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (LH)
SSL+
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
ESL
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the side airbag sensor assembly (LH).
(b) Using a service wire, connect SSL+ and ESL of the connector (on the side airbag sensor assembly side) between
the side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and the airbag
sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SSL+ and
ESL.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
ESL
(+)
H01010
H01058
H01050
(–)
SSL+
NG
H01166
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
1003
DI–769
DIAGNOSTICS
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness.
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (LH)
PREPARATION:
Using a service wire, connect VUPL and FSL of the connector
(on the side airbag sensor assembly side) between the side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and the airbag
sensor assembly, measure the resistance between VUPL and
FSL.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
VUPL
FSL
FSL
(+)
H01010
H01059
H01051
–
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
VUPL
NG
(–)
H01167
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
1004
DI–770
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness (to ground).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and the airbag
sensor assembly, measure the resistance between body
ground and each of SSL+, VUPL and FSL.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
SIde Airbag Sensor Assembly
(LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor Assembly
SSL+
FSL
VUPL
(+)
(–)
NG
H01008
H01052
H01168
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
7
ON
Check wire harness (to B+).
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor Assembly
FSL
SSL+
ESL
VUPL
H01008
AB0119
H01053
(+)
(–)
H08271
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side)
between the side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and the
airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between
body ground and each of SSL+, ESL, VUPL and FSL.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between side airbag sensor assembly (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
1005
DI–771
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Is DTC B1141/33 out put again?
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly (LH)
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ON
or
DLC1
E1
DTC B1141/33
Tc
H01007
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01066
H01170
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the side airbag sensor assembly (LH).
(b) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B1141/33 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1141/33 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NO
Go to step 9.
YES
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
1006
DI–772
DIAGNOSTICS
9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (RH)
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B1141/33
Tc
H01007
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01066
H01170
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the side airbag sensor (LH) from the connector and connect the side airbag sensor (RH) to the connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See step 5 on page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B1141/33 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1141/33 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
1007
DI–773
DIAGNOSTICS
10
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check side airbag sensor assembly (LH).
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01012
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01065
DTC B1140/32
Tc
H01164
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the side airbag sensor (LH) to the connector that
the side airbag sensor (RH) was connected to.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B1140/32 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1140/32 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace side airbag sensor assembly (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
1008
DI–774
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4LA–01
DTC
B1156/B1157/15
Front Airbag Sensor (RH) Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The front airbag sensor (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front airbag sensor (RH).
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B1156/B1157/15 is recorded when malfunction is detected in the front airbag sensor (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B1156/B1157/15
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Front airbag sensor (RH)
Wire harness
Engine room main wire harness
Airbag sensor assembly
Front airbag sensor (RH) malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
SR+
SR–
B–W
2
IU1
B–W
9
C18 SR+
BR–W
1
IU1
BR–W
20
C18 SR–
2
1
H02750
Author:
Date:
1009
DI–775
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check wire harness (to B+).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
ON
(+)
H03355
AB0119
H03363
(–)
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side)
between the front airbag sensor (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between body ground
and each of SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Voltage: Below 1 V
SR+
SR–
H03445
NG
Go to step 8.
OK
3
Check wire harness (to ground).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
(+)
(–)
H03353
H03361
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between body ground and
each of SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
SR+
SR–
H03443
NG
Go to step 9.
OK
Author:
Date:
1010
DI–776
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness.
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
SR+
(+)
(–)
SR–
H03355
H03356
H09518
NG
Go to step 10.
OK
5
Check wire harness.
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SR+
SR–
(+)
(–)
H03353
H09521H03356
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
SR+
PREPARATION:
Using a service wire, connect SR+ and SR– of the connector
(on the front airbag sensor (RH) side) between the airbag sensor assembly and the front airbag sensor (RH).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
SR–
H09523
NG
Go to step 11.
OK
Author:
Date:
1011
DI–777
DIAGNOSTICS
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check front airbag sensor (RH).
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SR+
H04504
H01062
–
(+)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front airbag sensor (RH)), measure
the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 300 – 1500 Ω
SR–
(–)
H08346
NG
Replace front airbag sensor (RH).
OK
Author:
Date:
1012
DI–778
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
→←
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B1156/B1157/15
E1
H02757
AB0118 AB0119
R13006H01063
Tc
H04014
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front airbag sensor (RH) connector and airbag sensor assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See Pub. No. RM572E1 on page DI–95)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See Pub. No. RM572E1 on page DI–95)
OK:
DTC B1156/B1157/15 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1156/B1157/15 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
1013
DI–779
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check engine room main wire harness (to B+).
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
←→
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Engine Room Main
Wire Harness
ON
SR+
(–)
SR–
(+)
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the engine room main wire harness connector on
the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the RH front door wire harness
side) between the airbag sensor assembly and the engine room main wire harness, measure the voltage between body ground and each of SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Voltage: Below 1 V
NG
H03354
AB0119
H06141
H08272
Repair or replace engine room main wire harness.
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and engine room main
wire harness.
9
Check engine room main wire harness (to ground).
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Engine Room Main
Wire Harness
(–)
SR+
SR–
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the engine room main wire harness connector on
the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the engine room main wire harness side)
between the airbag sensor assembly and the engine room main
wire harness, measure the resistance between body ground
and each of SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
NG
H03354
H06140
Repair or replace engine room main wire harness.
H08258
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and engine room main
wire harness.
Author:
Date:
1014
DI–780
DIAGNOSTICS
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check engine room main wire harness.
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Engine Room Main
Wire Harness
←→
SR+
H03354
H09519
–
(+)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SR–
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the engine room main wire harness connector on
the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the engine room main wire harness side)
between the airbag sensor assembly and the engine room main
wire harness, measure the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(–)
H09520
NG
Repair or replace engine room main wire harness.
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and engine room main
wire harness.
Author:
Date:
1015
DI–781
DIAGNOSTICS
11
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check engine room main wire harness.
Engine Room Main
Wire Harness
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
←→
SR+
SR–
SR+
(+)
H03352
H09521 H09519
SR–
(–)
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire harness connector
on the airbag sensor assembly side.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SR+ and SR– of the connector (on the engine room main wire harness side) between the engine room main wire harness and the front
airbag sensor (RH).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the engine room main wire harness side)
between the airbag sensor assembly and the engine room main
wire harness, measure the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
H09522
NG
Repair or replace engine room main wire harness.
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and engine room main
wire harness.
Author:
Date:
1016
DI–782
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4LB–01
DTC
B1158/B1159/16
Front Airbag Sensor (LH) Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The front airbag sensor (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front airbag sensor (LH).
For details of the function of each component, see OPERATION on page RS–2.
DTC B1158/B1159/16 is recorded when malfunction is detected in the front airbag sensor (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
B1158/B1159/16
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Front airbag sensor (LH)
Wire harness
Airbag sensor assembly
Front airbag sensor (LH) malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
SL+
SL–
Airbag Sensor Assembly
W–R
15
C18 SL+
BR
26
C18 SL–
2
1
H02751
Author:
Date:
1017
DI–783
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Check wire harness (to B+).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
ON
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side)
between the front airbag sensor (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between body ground
and each of SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Voltage: Below 1 V
SL+
(+)
NG
H01370
AB0119
H08065
(–)
SL–
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
H08066
OK
3
Check wire harness (to ground).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between body ground and
each of SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
(+)
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
SL+
NG
H01370
H08399
(–)
SL–
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
H08400
OK
Author:
Date:
1018
DI–784
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
SL+
(+)
NG
(–)
SL–
H01370
H08058
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
H09524
OK
5
Check wire harness.
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SL+
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
SL–
(+)
(–)
H09526
H09521H08058
SL+
SL–
H09525
PREPARATION:
Using a service wire, connect SL+ and SL– of the connector (on
the front airbag sensor (LH) side) between the airbag sensor
assembly and the front airbag sensor (LH).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
Author:
Date:
1019
DI–785
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check front airbag sensor (LH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front airbag sensor (LH)), measure
the resistance between SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Resistance: 300 – 1500 Ω
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
SL+
H01371
H01009
(+)
SL–
(–)
H01155
NG
Replace front airbag sensor (LH).
OK
Author:
Date:
1020
DI–786
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
→←
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01369
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01064
DTC B1158/B1159/16
Tc
H01154
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front airbag sensor (LH) connector and airbag sensor assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory.
(See page DI–626)
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC.
(See page DI–626)
OK:
DTC B1158/B1159/16 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1158/B1159/16 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
1021
DI–787
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BN–08
DTC
Normal
Source Voltage Drop
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS is equipped with a voltage–increase circuit (DC–DC converter) in the airbag sensor assembly in
case the source voltage drops.
When the battery voltage drops, the voltage–increase circuit (DC–DC converter) functions to increase the
voltage of the SRS to normal voltage.
The diagnosis system malfunction display for this circuit is different from other circuits that is when the SRS
warning light remains lit up and the DTC is a normal code, source voltage drop is indicated.
Malfunction in this circuit is not recorded in the airbag sensor assembly, and the source voltage returns to
normal, the SRS warning light automatically goes off.
DTC No.
Diagnosis
(Normal)
Source voltage drop
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery
FL MAIN
B–G
Instrument Panel J/B
40A AM1
1
2
2
1K
W
Fusible Link Block
1
1
F6
F4
100A
ALT
2
F9
Instrument Panel J/B
4
5
W–R 5
W–R
2L
1K
1B
Ignition Switch
7
6
B–R
3
1K
2
3
L–R
6
1K
Junction
Connector
A W–B
IG
30A AM2
5A IGN
15A CIG
7
1J
B
B–R
1
1B
1
2A
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
4
1N
B–O
5
C18 IG2
2
1N
GR
6
C18 ACC
1
1N
W–B
27
C18 E1
Instrument Panel J/B
H02288
Author:
Date:
1022
DI–788
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection.
LOCK
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
P Squib
D Squib
Spiral
Cable
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
P/T Squib (LH)
Side Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Side Squib (LH)
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(b) Remove the steering wheel pad. (See page SR–11)
(c) Disconnect the connector of the front passenger airbag
assembly. (See page RS–28)
(d) Disconnect the connector of the side airbag assembly RH
and LH. (See page RS–40 and RS–52)
(e) Disconnect the connector of the seat belt pretensioner
RH and LH. (See page BO–126)
(f)
Disconnect the connectors of the airbag sensor assembly.
(See page RS–59)
(g) Disconnect the connector of the front airbag sensor LH
and RH. (See page RS–64)
(h) Disconnect the connector of the side airbag sensor assembly RH and LH. (See page RS–69)
CAUTION:
Store the steering wheel pad with the front surface facing
upward.
P/T Squib (RH)
Side Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Side Squib (RH)
H06508
H01026
H06509
Author:
Date:
1023
DI–789
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check source voltage.
ON
Airbag Sensor Assembly
ACC
(–)
AB0119
H01298
IG2
(+)
H01299
PREPARATION:
Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage each of IG2 and ACC on the sensor
and operate electric system. (defogger, wiper, headlight,
heater blower, etc.)
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
NG
Check harness between battery and airbag sensor assembly, and check battery and charging
system.
OK
3
Does SRS warning light turn off?
ON
H01249
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect the airbag sensor assembly connectors.
(e) Connect the side airbag assembly connectors.
(f)
Connect the seat belt pretensioner connectors.
(g) Connect the side airbag sensor assembly connectors.
(h) Connect the front airbag sensor connectors.
(i)
Turn ignition switch to ON.
CHECK:
Operate electric system (defogger, wiper, headlight, heater
blower, etc.) and check that SRS warning light goes off.
NO
Check for DTCs. If a DTC is output, perform troubleshooting for the DTC. If a normal code is output, replace airbag sensor assembly.
YES
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
1024
DI–790
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BO–08
SRS Warning Light Circuit Malfunction (Always lights up, when
ignition switch is in LOCK position.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter.
When the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light lights up for approx. 6 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned from the LOCK position to ACC or ON position, and then turns off automatically.
If there is a malfunction in the SRS, the SRS warning light lights up to inform the driver of the abnormality.
When terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 are connected, the DTC is displayed by blinking the SRS warning
light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery
FL MAIN
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
3
LA C18
Fusible Link Block
1
1
F4
F6
B–G
J3 Junction
Connector
B–Y
1
2A
B
A
W–R
LG
13
7
2J
Instrument Panel J/B
SRS Warning Light
2
IG2
LG
A
Engine Room J/B No.2
10A
ECU–B
Short Pin
12
2
1G
3
1W
W–R
A
LG
7
II3
DLC1
B–Y (*1)
LG (*2)
5 AB
J3 Junction
Connector
19
TC C18
P–B
B
LG–R
B
11
II3
LG–R (*3)
P–B (*4)
11
TC
DLC2
4
LG–R
B
TC
*1: TMMK Made, 1MZ–FE
*2: Except *1
*3: TMC Made
*4: TMMK Made
H02289
Author:
Date:
1025
DI–791
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
2
Does SRS warning light turn off?
Airbag Sensor Assembly
LOCK
AB0117
H01293
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the airbag sensor assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
CHECK:
Check operation of SRS warning light.
H01295
NO
Check SRS warning light circuit or terminal AB
circuit of DLC1.
YES
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
Author:
Date:
1026
DI–792
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BP–08
SRS Warning Light Circuit Malfunction (Does not light up, when
ignition switch is turned to ACC or ON.)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter.
When the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light lights up for approx. 6 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned from LOCK position to ACC or ON position, and then turns off automatically.
If there is a malfunction in the SRS, the SRS warning light lights up to inform the driver of the abnormality.
When terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 are connected, the DTC is displayed by blinking the SRS warning
light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–790.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ECU–B Fuse.
Fuse
N14677
PREPARATION:
Remove ECU–B fuse.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–B fuse.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
Fuse may be burnt out even if it appears to be OK during
visual inspection.
If fuse is OK, install it.
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
2
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–787)
Author:
Date:
1027
DI–793
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check SRS warning light circuit.
Airbag Sensor Assembly
ON
(+)
LA
(–)
AB0119
H01300
–
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage LA terminal of the harness side connector
of the airbag sensor assembly.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
H01301
NG
Check SRS warning light bulb or repair SRS
warning light circuit.
OK
Author:
Date:
1028
DI–794
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Does SRS warning light come on?
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(b) Connect the airbag sensor assembly connector.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
CHECK:
Check operation of SRS warning light.
P Squib
D Squib
Spiral
Cable
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
P/T Squib (LH)
Side Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Side Squib (LH)
P/T Squib (RH)
Side Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Side Squib (RH)
ON
H08325
AB0119 H02309
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
H08324
NO
Check terminal LA of airbag sensor assembly.
If normal, replace airbag sensor assembly.
YES
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use simulation method to check.
Author:
Date:
1029
DI–795
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Is new ECU–B fuse burnt out again?
NO
Using simulation method, reproduce malfunction symptoms. (See page IN–21)
YES
Check harness between ECU–B fuse and
SRS warning light.
Author:
Date:
1030
DI–796
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BQ–08
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
By connecting terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 the airbag sensor assembly is set in the DTC output mode.
The DTCs are displayed by blinking the SRS warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR
3
A
Tc
E1
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
J3 Junction
Connector
DLC1
LG–R (*1)
P–B (*2)
11
J22 (1MZ–FE)
J23 (5S–FE)
Junction Connector
11
II3
LG–R
B
P–B
B
19
A21 Tc
DLC2
A
3
E1
Tc
LG–R
4
B
BR
BR (*3)
BR (*4)
B
Junction
Connector
C
J7
B
J8
BR
J26
Junction
Connector
6
II3
J22
Junction Connector
BR
A
A
BR
B
BR (*3)
EC
EC
*1: TMC Made
*2: TMMK Made
*3: California, 1MZ–FE
*4: Except California
H08301
Author:
Date:
1031
DI–797
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the DTC is not displayed, do the following troubleshooting.
1
Does SRS warning light up for approx. 6 seconds?
LOCK
ACC
ON
PREPARATION:
Check operation of the SRS warning light after ignition switch
is turned from LOCK position to ACC or ON position.
or
AB0117 AB0118
H02309
AB0119
H02314
NO
Check SRS warning light system.
(See page DI–626)
YES
2
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
ACC
ON
or
E1
(–)
AB0118 AB0119
R14305
Tc
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
(+)
H00030
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
Author:
Date:
1032
DI–798
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal Tc of DLC1 and body ground.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal Tc of DLC1 and body
ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
ACC
Tc
or
(–)
(+)
OK
AB0118 AB0119
R14304
H00031
Check harness between terminal E1 of DLC1
and body ground.
NG
4
Check airbag sensor assembly.
LOCK
ACC
ON
or
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Tc
AB0117 AB0118 AB0119
H01302
H01303
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the airbag sensor assembly connector.
(d) Insert service wire into terminal Tc from back side as
shown in the illustration.
(e) Connect the airbag sensor assembly connector with service wire.
(f)
Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
(g) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(h) Connect service wire of terminal Tc to body ground.
CHECK:
Check operation of SRS warning light.
OK:
SRS waning light comes on.
NOTICE:
Pay due attention to the terminal connecting position to
avoid a malfunction.
OK
Check harness between the airbag sensor assembly and DLC1.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
Author:
Date:
1033
DI–799
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
If the DTC is displayed without a DTC check procedure, perform the following
troubleshooting.
1
Check resistance between terminal Tc of airbag sensor assembly and body
ground.
Airbag Sensor Assembly
LOCK
Tc
(–)
AB0119
H01304
(+)
H01305
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the airbag sensor assembly connector.
CHECK:
Check resistance between terminal Tc of the airbag sensor assembly connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
Author:
Date:
1034
DI–800
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05L–03
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshooting of the wireless door lock control system is based on the premise that the door lock control
system is operating normally. Accordingly, before troubleshooting the wireless door lock control system, first
make certain that the door lock control system is operating normally.
Perform troubleshooting in accodnce with procedure on the following page.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Customer Problem Analysis
Titles inside
are titles of pages in
this manual, with the page number indicated
in the bottom position. See the indicated
pages for detailed explanations.
DI–801
3
2
Symptom Simulation
Problem Symptom Confirmation
IN–21
Whole wireless
door lock control
system does not
operate
4
Some functions of wireless door lock
control system do not operate
Diagnostic Procedure
DI–802
5
Transmitter Inspection
DI–802
Transmitter Malfunction
Problem Symptoms Table
DI–809
6
Circuit Inspection
DI–810
Identification of Problem
7
8
Repair
Confirmation Test
END
Author:
Date:
1035
DI–801
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05M–02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
Registration No.
Customer’s Name
Registration Year
/
/
Frame No.
/
Date Vehicle Brought In
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather
Weather Conditions
When Problem Occurred
Outdoor Temperature
Place
km
Miles
Odometer Reading
/
Constant
Sometimes ( times per
day, month)
Once only
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
Various/Others
Warm
Hot
Cold (Approx.
°F (
Specific Locality(
Everywhere
/
Date Transmitter Battery Last Replaced
Cool
°C))
)
/
Problem Symptom
Whole wireless door lock control system does not operate.
Only door unlock operation is not possible.
Only door lock operation is not possible.
Only key confinement prevention function is not possible.
Wireless door lock function operates even each door is opened.
Only PANIC operation is not possible.
Wireless door lock functions incorrectly.
( Although one door is unlocked, when the transmitter switch is pressed, all doors become unlocked.)
When Front RH door is unlocked
When Front LH door is unlocked
When Rear RH door is unlocked
When Rear LH door is unlocked
Others
Author:
Date:
1036
DI–802
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05N–03
PRE–CHECK
1.
1
N13160
N13161
INSPECT TRANSMITTER
Check the transmitter operation.
HINT:
This inspection is not directly for the purpose of checking the capaciy of the transmitter battery, but is performed when remote
control operation becomes difficult or impossible, in order to ascertain if this is caused by low battery capacity.
PREPARATION:
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry outward the cover.
(b) Remove the battery.
CHECK:
(a) Connect 4 new 1.5–V dry–cell batteries in series. Connect the battery terminal to the battery receptacle side
terminal and the battery terminal to the bottom terminal
to provide 6 V to the transmitter.
(b) Push the wireless door lock remote control switch on the
side of the transmitter body and operate the door lock by
remote control.
OK:
Remote control operation is possible.
I00239
OK
Replace the battery for transmitter.
(See page DI–802)
NG
Replace transmitter and registration of recognition code. (See page DI–802)
Author:
Date:
1037
DI–803
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
REPLACE WIRELESS DOOR LOCK ECU AND TRANSMITTER
HINT:
Disassembly and assembly of the transmitter includes details
of spare parts and replacement procedure for detective parts
found through troubleshooting.
Each part is a precision electronic component so handle with
care.
(a) Spare parts and replacement procedure for malfunctioning parts (transmitter malfunction):
(1) Prepare a new transmitter.
(2) Registration of recogition code.
(3) Check that door lock remote control operation
works.
Destroy
Transmitter
New Parts
Transmitter
ECU
EPROM
Registration
of recogition
code.
–
ECU
I00306
New Part
(b)
Spare parts and replacement procedure for malfunctioning parts (battery malfunction):
(1) Prepare a new battery.
(2) Remove the battery from transmitter.
(3) Install a new battery into transmitter.
(c)
Spare parts and replacement procedure for malfunctioning parts (ECU malfunction):
(1) Prepare a new ECU.
(2) Remove the ECU from the vehicle.
(3) Install a new ECU in the vehicle.
(4) Registration of recogition code.
Dispose of
N13157
New Parts
Destory ECU
Registration
of recogition
code
I00307
Author:
Date:
1038
DI–804
DIAGNOSTICS
(d)
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Replace the battery for transmitter.
(1) Using a screwdriver, pry outward the cover.
N13159
(2)
(3)
(4)
Remove the battery.
Set a new battery into the transmitter.
Install the cover to the transmitter.
N13160
3.
REGISTRATION OF RECOGNITION CODE
The recognition code of the transmitter is electronically registered (written to and stored) in an EEPROM contained in the
wireless door lock ECU. This makes it possible to register up to
2 different codes in the EEPROM.
New recognition codes can be registered after all previous
codes have been erased. A transmitter code can be registered
into the EEPROM by following the steps numbered (1) to (5).
(1)
GND
PRG
PRG
Wireless Door
Lock ECU
GND
Remote Control Mirror
Switch Connector
The wireless door lock ECU and remote control mirror switch are connected to each other via a PRG
terminal, and the GND terminal of the remote control mirror switch connector is grounded to body.
Remove the connector from the remote control mirror switch, and use a test lead to short the PRG and
GND connector together. As a result, the PRG terminal of the wireless door lock ECU will be
grounded to body and will cause all transmitter recognition codes previously registered in the EEPROM to be erased. At the same time, the ECU will
respond by operating once the lock and unlock
functions of all the doors, and the open function of
the trunk lid.
I08491
Author:
Date:
1039
DI–805
DIAGNOSTICS
–
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
4.
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
A transmitter recognition code is registered by
pressing any single button of the transmitter to be
registered. Once the code is registered, the ECU
responds again by operating once the lock and unlock functions of all the doors.
To register the recognition code of an additional
transmitter, follow the procedure shown in (2).
After completing the registration of the codes, remove the test lead from the remote control mirror
switch connector terminals to allow the system to
revert to the normal operation.
Using the registered transmitter, verify that the system operates properly.
DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
Start
HINT: Diagnostic mode may be exited
at any time by ungrounding terminal 9
Unlock all doors manually
Insert key in ignition key cylinder and open driver’s door
Ground terminal 9 of the wireless door lock ECU and
wait more 1 second.
Remove key from ignition key cylinder and close
driver’s door within 10 seconds.
If not performing this operation
within 10 seconds after the
above operation, the mode will
not change into the diagnostic
mode.
Press any button on transmitter within 10 seconds.
If not performing this operation
within 10 seconds after the
above operation, the mode will
not change into the diagnostic
mode.
CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE
Author:
Date:
1040
DI–806
DIAGNOSTICS
Does each
door lock
knob operate?
Yes
How does
it opetate?
Door lock motor of all the doors
operate to lock side 3 times.
Motor feedback failure
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
No
RF (ECU failure) DATA reception
error (Transmitter of ECU failure)
Exit diagnostic mode, and check
transmitter batteries.
If bad, replace batteries and go to
start.
If not starting, replace transmitter and
go to
start.
If still not starting, replace ECU and
go to start.
Door lock motor of all the doors
operate to lock side 1 time.
Valid recognition code received
Diagnostic check OK
Check motor feedback for input
line to receiver:
If bad, fix wiring or replace motor.
Other wise, replace receiver and go to start.
Author:
Date:
1041
DI–807
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05O–03
PARTS LOCATION
Ignition Switch
Key Unlock Warning Switch
Wireless Door Lock ECU
Transmitter
Instrument Panel Junction Block
Integration Relay
Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
Engine Room Junction Block
DOME Fuse
Door Lock Motor
Door Unlock
Detection Switch
Door Lock Motor
Door Unlock Detection
Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Door Lock Motor
Door Unlock
Detection Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
I00217
I00216
I00215
I00241
Author:
Date:
1042
DI–808
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI1KR–03
TERMINALS OF ECU
7
6
5
15 14
4
3
13 12 11 10
2
1
9
8
I00227
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
1 – Ground (GND – Ground )
W–B
4–G
Ground
d ( TAIL – G
Ground
d)
G–R
5 – Ground
G
d ( PINI – Ground
G
d)
LG
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
Always.
Below 1 V
TAIL lamps ”ON”
Below 1 V
TAIL lamps ”OFF”
10 – 14 V
Always.
7–G
Ground
d ( UL3 – G
Ground
d)
R–G
4–6V
Push the PANIC switch.
Below 1.5 V
Door key lock and unlock switch ”UNLOCK”.
(Driver’s Door)
Below 1.5 V
Door key lock and unlock switch ”OFF” or ”LOCK”.
(Driver’s Door)
8 – 10 V
8 – 1 (+B – E )
R
Always.
10 – 14 V
9 – Ground (PRG – Ground )
V
Ignition switch ”ON”
10 – 14 V
Key unlock warning switch ”ON”.
(Key is inserted into key cylinder)
Below 1 V
Key unlock warning switch ”OFF”.
10 – 14 V
Door unlock detection switch ”ON”.
(Driver’s Door)
Below 1 V
Door unlock detection switch ”OFF”.
(Driver’s Door)
10 – 14 V
Door unlock detection switch ”ON”.
(Passenger’s Door)
Below 1 V
Door unlock detection switch ”OFF”.
(Passenger’s Door)
10 – 14 V
Door unlock detection switch ”ON”.
(Either Rear Door)
Below 1 V
Door unlock detection switch ”OFF”.
(All Rear Doors)
10 – 14 V
Door courtesy switch ”ON”
Below 1 V
Door courtesy switch ”OFF”
10 – 14 V
Door key lock and unlock switch ”LOCK”
Below 1 V
10 – Ground (KSW – Ground )
11 – G
Ground
d (LSWD – G
Ground)
d)
12 – G
Ground
d (LSWP – G
Ground)
d)
13 – G
Ground(LSWR
d(LSWR – G
Ground)
d)
L–B
L–R
Y
L–Y
14 – G
Ground
d (CTY – G
Ground
d)
R–W
15 – Ground
G
d (L – Ground
G
d)
L–W
Door key lock and unlock switch ”OFF” or ”UNLOCK”
Author:
8 – 10 V
Date:
1043
DI–809
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05Q–03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Perform troubleshooting of the circuit for the applicable problem symptom in the order given in the chart below. Proceed to the page located for each circuit.
HINT:
Troubleshooting of the wireless door lock control system is based on the premise that the door lock
control system and theft deterrent system are operating normally. Accordingly, before troubleshooting
the wireless door lock control system, first make certain that the door lock control system and theft deterrent system are operating normally.
If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the flow chart
for each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to continue the check.
If the trouble still reappears even through there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits, check
and replace the Wireless Door Lock ECU as the last step.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
3. ECU Power Source Circuit.
4. Door Courtesy Switch Circuit.
5. Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch Circuit.
(Unlock Side)
6. Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch Circuit.
(Lock Side)
7. Key Unlock Warning Switch Circuit.
8. Wireless Door Lock ECU.
DI–810
DI–821
DI–815
1. Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch Circuit
(Unlock Side)
2. Door Unlock Detection Switch Circuit
3. Wireless Door Lock ECU.
DI–815
Only door unlock operation is not possible (Lock operation is possible).
Only door lock operation is not possible (Unlock operation is possible).
1. Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch Circuit
(Lock Side)
2. Wireless Door Lock ECU
DI–817
Only key confinement prevention function is not possible.
1. Key Unlock Warning Switch Circuit
2. Wireless Door Lock ECU
DI–819
IN–31
Wireless door lock function operates even when each door is
opened.
Automatic lock function operates even if any door is opened
within 30 seconds after all doors are unlocked by wireless door
lock control system.
1. Door Courtesy Switch Circuit
2. Wireless Door Lock ECU
DI–821
IN–31
Wireless door lock functions incorrectly.
(Although one door is unlocked, when the transmitter switch is
pressed, all doors are unlocked.)
1. Door Unlock Detection Switch Circuit
2. Wireless Door Lock ECU
DI–813
IN–31
Warning operation will not be performed even if the panic button is
pressed.
1. Panic Circuit
2. Wireless Door Lock ECU
DI–823
IN–31
All functions of wireless door lock control system do no operate.
Author:
Date:
DI–817
DI–819
IN–31
DI–819
IN–31
IN–31
1044
DI–810
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05R–03
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
ECU Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is always applied to the terminal +B of the wireless door lock ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Wireless Door Lock ECU
Engine Room J/B No.2
B
1
2A
SHORT PIN
12
2J
R
DOME
1 1W
1 F6
Instrument
panel J/B
FL BLOCK
8 1G
1 F4
B–G
R–Y DIODE(DOME) E
2 R J16
1
J/C
D
J17
R 8 RR–
FL MAIN
J5
W–B
A
A W–B 1
GND
Battery
IF
I00225
Author:
Date:
1045
DI–811
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check DOME fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove DOME fuse from engine room junction block.
CHECK:
Check continuity of DOME fuse.
OK:
Below 1.0 Ω or continuity
N14677
NG
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to DOME fuse.
(See attached wiring diagram.)
OK
2
Check voltage between terminals +B and E of wireless door lock ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
Remove the wireless door lock ECU from No.1 instrument panel brace.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals +B and GND of wireless
door lock ECU.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
LOCK
E(–)
AB0117
N14690
+B(+)
I00242
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–809).
NG
Author:
Date:
1046
DI–812
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal GND of wireless
door lock ECU and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and repair harness and connector between wireless door lock control ECU and battery.
Author:
Date:
1047
DI–813
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05S–03
Door Unlock Detection Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The door unlock detection switch is built into the door lock motor assembly. The switch is OFF when the
door lock knob is in Lock position, and is ON When the Knob is in Unlock position.
Furthermore, the door unlock detection switch circuit has terminal +B connected inside the theft deterrent
ECU, when the door unlock detection switch is OFF, battery positive voltage is applied to the terminal of the
door unlock detection switch circuit of the wireless door lock ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
F
F
15
LSWP T4
L–R
J37 J/C
F
Y
Y
C
11
IE1
L–R
L–R
J38
W–B*1
W–B*1
A
1
3
A
20
IE1
W–B
J/C
E
J10
L–Y
E J10
4
L–Y
BO1
L–Y
1
4
2
3
2
IF2
W–B
L–Y
1*1
4*2
4*1
1*2
J39
3
A
Door Unlock Detection
Switch Rear LH
A
J/C
Door Unlock Detection
Switch Front RH
W–B
IJ
D
J9
13
W6 LSWR
L–Y
J9 D
L–Y
3
L–Y
IN2
4
BP1
1
L–Y
2
6
BO1
W–B*1
W–B*1
20 IM1
3
7
Door Unlock
W–B
Detection Switch
1V
1G
Front LH
IE
Instrument Panel J/B
16
LSWR T4
W–B*2
Y
2
J/C
C
C
11
IM1
Y
W–B*2
4
2
Wireless Door
Lock ECU
11
W6 LSWD
12
W6 LSWP
J6
J/C
Theft Deterrent ECU
14
L–R
LSWD T4
4
W–B
6
BP1
W–B
3
J40
W–B
W–B
J/C
BL
Door Unlock Detection
Switch Rear RH
BN
IK
*1: TMC Made
*2: TMMK Made
I08425
Author:
Date:
1048
DI–814
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals LSWD, LSWP and LSWR of wireless door lock
ECU connector and body ground.
LSWR(+)
I00273
N14691
LSWD(+)
LSWP(+)
I00243
PREPARATION:
Remove the wireless door lock ECU from No.1 instrument panel brace.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between each of terminals LSWD, LSWP and
LSWR of wireless door lock ECU connector and body ground,
when the respective door lock knobs involved are pushed to the
lock side.
OK:
Voltage 10 – 14 V
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–809).
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between wireless door lock ECU and door unlock
detection switch.
Author:
Date:
1049
DI–815
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05T–03
Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch Circuit (Unlock Side)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Key–operated switch is built into the door key cylinder. When the key is turned to the lock side, the lock
terminal of the switch is grounded, and when the key is turned to the unlock side the unlock terminal is
grounded.
Furthermore, the door key lock and unlock switch circuit has terminal +B connected inside the theft deterrent
ECU, when neither the lock nor unlock terminal of the key lock and unlock switch are grounded, battery positive voltage is applied to the door key lock and unlock switch circuit of the wireless door lock ECU.
( Tr inside the ECU coming ON causes the wireless door lock ECU to output a signal to unlock all the doors.)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Integration Relay
Wireless Door Lock ECU
7
UL2 W6
I18
4*1
19*2
Theft Deterrent ECU
5*1
20*2
I18
R–G B
B
B
R–G
J6
J/C
R–G
B
L
J37 J/C
A
A
R–G
W–B
UNLOCK
L 3
2
Door Key
Lock and
Unlock
Switch
LOCK
LH
J38
1
*3
A W–B
A
10
T4
UL2
W–B
3 IM1
R–G 3
W–B*3
UL3
L A
3 IE1
20 IE1
L
9
T4
2
UNLOCK
RH
LOCK
IM1 20
1 J39
W–B*3
*3
A W–B
A
J/C
J/C
W–B*4
W–B*4
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1G
3
1V
IE
*1: w/o Theft Deterrent System
*2: w/ Theft Deterrent System
*3: TMC Made
*4: TMMK Made
IJ
I08426
Author:
Date:
1050
DI–816
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals UL2 of wireless door lock ECU connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the wireless door lock ECU from No.1 instrument panel brace.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal UL2 of wireless door lock
ECU connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
UL2(+)
I00300
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–809).
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between wireless door lock ECU and door key lock and
unlock switch.
Author:
Date:
1051
DI–817
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05U–03
Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch Circuit (Lock Side)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to page DI–815.
Tr inside the wireless door lock ECU coming ON causes the theft deterrent ECU to output a signal to lock
all the doors.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Integration Relay
I18 3*1
18*2
Wireless Door Lock ECU
L–W
15
L
W6
*1: w/o Theft Deterrent System
*2: w/ Theft Deterrent System
*3: TMC Made
*4: TMMK Made
Theft Deterrent ECU
J37
J/C
B
L–W
B
L–W
B
B
B
L–W
4 IE1
W–B
3
20 IE1
LH
UNLOCK
J38
4 IM1
L–W
2
LOCK
3
Door Key
Lock and
Unlock
Switch
UNLOCK
L2
W–B
L–W
2
LOCK
IM1 20
1 J39
W–B*3
A
RH
1
W–B*3
W–B*3
A
A
A
W–B*3
J/C
J/C
W–B*4
W–B*4
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1G
8
T4
L–W
3
1V
W–B
IE
IJ
I08427
Author:
Date:
1052
DI–818
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal L of wireless door lock ECU connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the wireless door lock ECU from No.1 instrument panel brace.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal L of wireless door lock ECU
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage 10 – 14 V
L(+)
N14693
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–809).
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between wireless door lock ECU and door key lock and
unlock switch.
Author:
Date:
1053
DI–819
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05V–03
Key Unlock Warning Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder, the key unlock warning switch comes ON, and when
the key is not inserted the switch is OFF.
When the key unlock warning switch is ON, the ECU operates the key confinement prevention function.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Wireless Door Lock ECU
Instrument Panel J/B
7
Integration Relay
5
1D
L–B
B
J9
B
J10
10
W6 KSW
L–B
5 1M
L–B
1
Key Unlock
Warning
Switch
2
Instrument Panel J/B
W–B
3
1M
7
1J
J11
J/C
W–B
A
IG
I00224
Author:
Date:
1054
DI–820
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal KSW of wireless door lock ECU connector and
body ground.
KSW
N14694
PREPARATION:
Remove the wireless door lock ECU from No.1 instrument panel brace.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal KSW of wireless door lock
ECU connector and body ground, when key plate is not inserted
in the key cylinder.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–809).
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between wireless door lock ECU and key unlock warning switch.
Author:
Date:
1055
DI–821
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05W–03
Door Courtesy Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The door courtesy switch comes ON when the door is opened and goes OFF when door is closed. Furthermore. the door courtesy switch circuit has terminal +B connected inside the theft deterrent ECU . Battery
positive voltage is applied to terminal DSWD of the theft deterrent ECU when all doors are closed, i.e., when
the door courtesy switches of all doors are OFF.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Deterrent
ECU
4
A
DSWD T4 R–G J10
Wireless Door
Lock ECU
Instrument Panel J/B
Integration Relay
1
C
J9 R–G 1G
4
6
4 1G
7 1S 12 1S
R–W
14
W6 CTY
R–W
1
CTY T4
D J33 E J34
D
E
J33
J34
R–W
D J33
R–W
R–G
1
IN2 8
R–W
R–G
5
DSWP T4
R–W
2
E J33
E
J33
R–G
R–W
D J34
R–G
1
1
6
R–G
IN2
Door Courtesy Switch
1
1
Front RH Rear RH
Front LH Rear LH
I00223
Author:
Date:
1056
DI–822
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of open door warning light.
CHECK:
Check that open door warning light comes ON when each door is opened, and goes OFF when all doors
are closed.
NG
Check open door warning light circuit
OK
2
Check voltage between terminal CTY of wireless door lock ECU connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the wireless door lock ECU from No.1 instrument panel brace.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal CTY of wireless door lock
ECU connector and body ground, when all doors are closed.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
CTY(+)
N14695
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–809).
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between wireless door lock ECU and door courtesy
switch.
Author:
Date:
1057
DI–823
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DI05X–04
Panic Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit will transmit a panic signal from a wireless door lock ECU to a theft deterrent ECU.
When the key is not inserted in the ignition key cylinder and the theft deterrent ECU receives the panic signal
from the wireless door lock ECU, warning operation will be performed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Deterrent ECU
Wireless Door Lock ECU
5
PANI W6
18
T4 PANI
LG
I00301
Author:
Date:
1058
DI–824
DIAGNOSTICS
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal PANI of theft deterrent ECU connector and body
ground.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal PANI of theft deterrent ECU
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 4 – 6 V
PANI
I00310
OK
Exchange theft deterrent ECU.
NG
2
Check the panic signal (Theft deterrent ECU side)
CHECK:
Check the signal of the terminal PANI when pushing the PANIC
switch of the transmitter.
PANI
HINT:
Check the signal using the oscilloscope or oscilloscope function
of TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Output the signal as shown in the illustration.
Output signal
Push the panic switch
4–6V
Below 1 V
300m sec
I00309
OK
Exchange theft deterrent ECU.
NG
Author:
Date:
1059
DI–825
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Check the panic signal (Wireless door lock ECU side)
CHECK:
Check the signal of the terminal PANI when pressing the PANIC
switch of the transmitter.
PANI
OK:
Output the signal shown on the previous page.
I00308
NG
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–809).
OK
Check and repair harness and connector between wireless door lock ECU and theft deterrent
ECU.
Author:
Date:
1060
DI–826
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06M–04
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshooting of the theft deterrent system is based on the premise that the door lock control system is
operating normally. Accordingly, before troubleshooting the theft deterrent system, first make certain that
the door lock control system is operating normally.
For troubleshooting use a volt/ohm meter.
Be sure to use troubleshooting procedure appropriate to the diagnostic tool being used.
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following page.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Customer Problem Analysis
Titles inside
are titles of pages in this
manual with the page number indicated in the
bottom portion.
See the indicated pages
for detailed explanations.
P. DI–827
Symptom does not occur
2
Problem Symptom Confirmation
3
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
Symptom occur
4
Problem Symptoms Table
P. DI–837
5
Circuit Inspection
P. DI–838 ∼ DI–866
Identification of Problem
6
7
Repair
Confirmation Test
Step 5, 7 : Diagnostic steps permitting the use
of the TOYOTA hand–held tester
and TOYOTA break–out–box.
End
Author:
Date:
1061
DI–827
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06N–05
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
Frame No.
Date of Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
/
Date Problem First Occurred
Constant
Once only
Frequency Problem Occurs
Weather Conditions
When Problem
Occurred
km
Mile
Odometer Reading
Sometimes (
/
Times per day, month)
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Various/Others
Hot
Warm
Cool
Outdoor temperature
Cold (Approx.
°F ( °C))
Weather
Snowy
Problem Symptom
Theft deterrent system cannot be set.
Indicator light does not flash when the theft deterrent system is set.
(It stays on or does not light at all.)
Theft deterrent system
does not operate.
When unlocked using the
door lock knob.
When the engine hood is
opened.
System cannot be
canceled once set.
When door is unlocked using key or wireless door lock control system.
When the key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder and turned to ACC or ON
position.
(However, only when the system has never operated)
When the luggage compartment door is opened with the key.
System cannot be
canceled during warning
operation.
When door is unlocked using key or wireless door lock control system.
When the key is inserted in the ignition key cylinder and turned to ACC or ON
position.
Malfunction
Horns only
Theft deterrent horn only
Headlights only
Taillights only
Starter cut only
Door lock operation only
Warning operation starts when the system is set and the door or luggage compartment door is opened with
the key.
Others.
Author:
Date:
1062
DI–828
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI1KU–02
PRE–CHECK
1.
Active arming mode:
SETTING THE THEFT DETERRENT MODE
The system will be automatically set to the theft deterrent mode
about 30 seconds after the setting processes listed below are
performed.
Setting Processes: (do processes (1)(4) in the order)
(1) Remove the ignition key from the key cylinder.
(2) Close all entry points (door, hood and luggage
compartment door).
(3) Use any one of the following methods to lock all the
doors depending on a given condition.
Use the key to lock the driver or passenger
side door. (as a result, all the doors(including
the engine hood and luggage compartment
door) will be closed and locked), or
Use the remote control to lock any door (as a
result, all the doors(including the engine
hood and luggage compartment door) will be
closed and locked), or
If the front right or left door is unlocked when
both the rear doors are already locked, lock
and close the remaining unlocked door by
hand (as a result, all the doors(including the
engine hood and luggage compartment door)
will be closed and locked).
Close all doors and lock with the engine hood
or luggage compartment door opened, and
close the engine hood or all the doors(including the engine hood and luggage compartment door).
(4) About 30 seconds after the above process (3), the
theft deterrent mode will automatically start.
HINT:
The closing/locking of all the entry points (doors, hood and luggage) must remain unchanged for about 30 seconds, the system will start the theft deterrent mode.
2.
Passive arming mode:
SETTING THE THEFT DETERRENT MODE
The system will be automatically set to the theft deterrent mode
about 30 seconds after the setting processes listed below are
performed.
Setting Processes:
(1) Remove the ignition key from the key cylinder.
(2) Open and close any entry points (door, hood and
luggage compartment door).
Now, all the entry points are closed.
Author:
Date:
1063
DI–829
DIAGNOSTICS
–
(3)
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
About 30 seconds after the process–(2), on the previous page the Theft Deterrent mode will automatically start.
HINT:
If, while following above steps, you use the key or the remote
control to lock the door, the system will be set to ACTIVE ARMING MODE.
3.
THEFT DETERRENT OPERATION
When the system is set to the theft deterrent mode and any of
the following conditions are met, the system sounds the horns
and flashes the headlights and the taillights for about 1 minute.
At the same time locks all doors (If all doors are not locked at
once, the system repeats door locking operation every 0.55 seconds during the one–minute alarm time).
Condition
(1) Any of the doors (Including the engine hood and
luggage compartment door) is unlocked or opened
without the key. *1
(2) The battery terminal is disconnected and reconnected. *2
(3) The system receives panic signal from remote keyless entry. *3
*1: Only active arming mode.
*2: When the ignition key is not inserted in the key
cylinder.
0.25 ± 0.05 sec.
0.25 ± 0.05 sec.
ON
OFF
Horns Sounding and Lights Flashing
Pattern
0.2 ± 0.05 sec.
ON
OFF
0.55 ± 0.05 sec.
Output of Key Lock Pattern
I00228
Author:
Date:
1064
DI–830
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
4.
CANCELLATION OF THEFT DETERRENT OPERATION OR MODE
The theft deterrent operation of mode can be cancelled when
any of the following conditions is met.
No.
Condition
Cancel of Operation
Cancel of Mode
1
Unlock front doors with the key
Effective
Effective
2
Unlock doors with remote keyless entry
Effective
Effective
3
Insert key into ignition key cylinder and turn
it to ACC or ON position
Effective
Effective
4
About 1 minute passes after theft deterrent
operation begins
Automatic stop *1
–
5
Unlock the luggage compartment door with
the key or keyless entry.
Uneffective
Effective
6
Unlock the luggage compartment door with
the keyless entry.
Uneffective
Effective
7
If the system receives panic signal again or
unlock signal when the system is activated
by panic signal
Effective *2
Uneffective
6
If the system receives unlock signal when
the system is activated by panic signal
Effective
Effective
*1: The system is set to the theft deterrent mode again in
about 2 seconds after the operation stops, if all doors are
closed.
*2: The alarm caused by the panic signal malces the system in the previous condition.
5.
INDICATOR LIGHT (LED)
The indicator light functions as shown below according to the
system condition in the theft deterrent mode. It remains OFF in
the initial state.
Security only:
0.75 ± 0.1 sec.
1.25 ± 0.1 sec.
ON
System Condition
OFF
Blinking Pattern
I00229
Indicator Light
During set preparation time
ON
When the mode is set*
OFF
When alarm is activated
ON
When the system is temporally cancelled*
OFF
*: The indicator flashes with the output from the immobiliser.
6.
KEEPING POWER SUPPLY FUNCTION IN CASE OF
DOME FUSE OPEN
Even if the dome fuse blows open on the theft deterrent mode,
the system will keep working on the theft deterrent mode.
Author:
Date:
1065
DI–831
DIAGNOSTICS
7.
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CHANGING METHOD OF PASSIVE MODE
(ON or OFF)
Remove the ignition key from key cylinder.
All the doors, engine hood and luggage
compartment door are closed and unlocked.
Any of doors is locked and unlocked by turns
3 times by the key or remote control.
Input to the vehicle
Output from the vehicle
Within
30 sec.
Driver’s side doors is opened.
Driver’s side knob for doorlock is locked and
unlocked 3 times.
The system starts force lock at once after 2
sec.
Driver’s side knob for door lock is unlocked.
Within
20 sec.
Driver’s side door is closed and opened 2
times
Driver’s side door is closed and opened 4
times
Driver’s side knob for door lock is locked and
unlocked.
Driver’s side knob for door lock is locked and
unlocked.
The system starts force lock at once after 2
sec.
The system starts force lock at once after 2
sec.
PASSIVE MODE OFF
PASSIVE MODE ON
HINT:
Initial mode is PASSIVE MODE OFF.
If there is a different signal in the middle of changing, it is invalied.
Author:
Date:
1066
DI–832
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA hand–held tester
ECU
8.
(a)
(b)
TOYOTA Break–out–box
N09348
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
ECU TERMINAL VALUES MEASUREMENT BY USING
TOYOTA BREAK–OUT–BOX AND TOYOTA HAND–
HELD TESTER
Hook up the TOYOTA break–out–box and TOYOTA
hand–held tester to the vehicle.
Read the ECU input/ output values by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” function.
This records the measured values and is effective in the diagnosis of intermittent problems.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester / TOYOTA
break–out–box operator’s manual for further details.
Author:
Date:
1067
DI–833
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06P–05
PARTS LOCATION
Theft Deterrent Horn
E/G Room J/B No.2
DOME Fuse
HORN Fuse
ECU–IG Fuse
CIG Fuse
ST Relay
HORN Relay
Headlight Control
Relay
Horn
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch
Key Unlock Warning Switch
Theft Deterrent ECU
Ignition Switch
I00233
I00234
Instrument Panel J/B
DOOR Fuse
ST Fuse
Taillight Control
Relay
I00236
Author:
Date:
1068
DI–834
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Door Key Lock and
Unlock Switch
Door Lock Assembly
Door Unlock Detection
Switch
Luggage Compartment
Door Key Lock and
Unlock Switch
Door Courtesy
Switch
Door Lock Assembly
Door Unlock Detection
Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Luggage Compartment
Door Courtesy Switch
Door Lock Assembly
Door Unlock Detection
Switch
I00235
Author:
Date:
1069
DI–835
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI1KV–03
TERMINALS OF ECU
T4
T3
I01920
Symbols (Terminals No.)
CTY ↔ E
(T4–1 ↔ T3–7)
DSWL ↔ E
(T4–2 ↔ T3–7)
DSWH ↔ E
(T4–3 ↔ T3–7)
DSWD ↔ E
(T4–4 ↔ T3–7)
DSWP ↔ E
(T4–5 ↔ T3–7)
Wiring Color
R W ↔ W–B
R–W
W B
R Y ↔ W–B
R–Y
W B
B ↔ W–B
W B
R G ↔ W–B
R–G
W B
R G ↔ W–B
R–G
W B
KSW ↔ E
(T4–6 ↔ T3–7)
L B ↔ W–B
L–B
W B
LUG ↔ E
(T4–7 ↔ T3–7)
G W ↔ W–B
G–W
W B
L2 ↔ E
(T4–8 ↔ T3–7)
UL3 ↔ E
(T4–9 ↔ T3–7)
UL2 ↔ E
(T4–10 ↔ T3–7)
L W ↔ W–B
L–W
W B
R G ↔ W–B
R–G
W B
L↔W
W–B
B
Condition
STD Value
Door courtesy switch ”ON”
(Rear door opened)
Below 1 Ω
Door courtesy switch ”OFF”
(Rear door closed)
1 MΩ or higher
Luggage compartment door courtesy switch ”ON”
(Luggage compartment door opened)
Below 1 Ω
Luggage compartment door courtesy switch ”OFF”
(Luggage compartment door closed)
1 MΩ or higher
Engine hood courtesy switch ”ON”
(Engine hood opened)
Below 1 Ω
Engine hood courtesy switch ”OFF”
(Engine hood closed)
1 MΩ or higher
Door courtesy switch ”ON”
(Driver’s door opened)
Below 1 Ω
Door courtesy switch ”OFF”
(Driver’s door Closed)
1 MΩ or higher
Door courtesy switch ”ON”
(Passenger’s door opened)
Below 1 Ω
Door courtesy switch ”OFF”
(Passenger’s door closed)
1 MΩ or higher
Key unlock warning switch ”ON”
(Key inserted)
Below 1 Ω
Key unlock warning switch ”OFF”
(Key removed)
1 MΩ or higher
Luggage compartment door key lock and unlock switch ”ON”
Below 1 Ω
Luggage compartment door key lock and unlock switch ”OFF”
1 MΩ or higher
Door key lock and unlock switch ”LOCK”
(Driver’s and passenger’s doors)
Below 1 Ω
Door key lock and unlock switch ”UNLOCK”
(Driver’s and passenger’s doors)
1 MΩ or higher
Door key lock and unlock switch ”UNLOCK”
(Driver’s door)
Below 1 Ω
Door key lock and unlock switch ”LOCK”
(Driver’s door)
1 MΩ or higher
Door key lock and unlock switch ”UNLOCK”
(passenger’s door)
Below 1 Ω
Door key lock and unlock switch ”LOCK”
(passenger’s door)
Author:
1 MΩ or higher
Date:
1070
DI–836
DIAGNOSTICS
+B1 ↔ Body ground
(T4–12 ↔ Body ground)
IG ↔ E
(T4–13 ↔ T3–7)
LSWD ↔ E
(T4–14 ↔ T3–7)
LSWP ↔ E
(T4–15 ↔ T3–7)
R ↔ W–B
B–R ↔ W–B
L R ↔ W–B
L–R
W B
Y ↔ W–B
W B
LSWR ↔ E
(T4–16 ↔ T3–7)
L Y ↔ W–B
L–Y
W B
PANI ↔ E
(T4–18 ↔ T3–7)
LG ↔ W–B
W B
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Always
10 – 14 V
Ignition switch is turned to ”ON” position
10 – 14 V
Door unlock detection switch ”ON”
(Driver’s door)
Below 1 Ω
Door unlock detection switch ”OFF”
(Driver’s door)
1 MΩ or higher
Door unlock detection switch ”ON”
(Passenger’s door)
Below 1 Ω
Door unlock detection switch ”OFF”
(Passenger’s door)
1 MΩ or higher
Door unlock detection switch ”ON”
(Rear door)
Below 1 Ω
Door unlock detection switch ”OFF”
(Rear door)
1 MΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
It is receiving panic signal from remote keyless entry
Except above mention
1 MΩ or hegher
+B2 ↔ Body ground
(T3–1 ↔ Body ground)
L–W ↔ Body
ground
Always
IND ↔ E
(T3–6 ↔ T3–7)
R–Y ↔ W–B
During set preparation
E ↔ Body ground
(T3–7 ↔ Body ground)
W–B ↔ Body
ground
Always
10 – 14 V
SH ↔ E
(T3–9 ↔ T3–7)
W–L ↔ W–B
Always
10 – 14 V
HEAD ↔ E
(T3–10 ↔ T3–7)
R–B ↔ W–B
Light control switch ”HEAD”
10 – 14 V
TAIL ↔ E
(T3–11 ↔ T3–7)
G–R ↔ W–B
Light control switch ”TAIL” or ”HEAD”
10 – 14 V
HORN ↔ E
(T3–12 ↔ T3–7)
G–B ↔ W–B
Horn switch ”OFF”
10 – 14 V
10 – 14 V
3–5V
Author:
Date:
1071
DI–837
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06R–06
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Proceed to the reference page shown in the matrix chart below for each malfunction symptom and troubleshoot for each circuit.
HINT:
Troubleshooting of the theft deterrent system is based on the premise that the door lock control system is
operating normally. Accordingly, before troubleshooting the theft deterrent system, first make certain that
the door lock control system is operating normally.
Details of Problem
Inspecting Circuit*1
1. Indicator light circuit
DI–838
2. ECU power source circuit
DI–840
3. Key unlock warning switch circuit
DI–853
4. Luggage compartment door key
lock and unlock switch circuit
DI–855
5. Luggage compartment door
courtesy switch circuit
DI–858
6. Door key lock and unlock switch
circuit
DI–855
7. Door courtesy switch circuit
DI–864
8. Door unlock detection switch circuit
DI–862
9. Engine hood courtesy switch circuit
DI–866
Indicator light circuit
DI–838
Door unlock detection switch circuit
DI–862
Luggage compartment door
courtesy switch circuit
DI–858
Engine hood courtesy switch circuit
DI–866
Horns do not sound
Horn relay circuit
DI–845
Theft deterrent horn does not sound
Theft deterrent horn circuit
DI–843
Headlight control relay circuit
DI–847
Taillight control relay circuit
DI–849
Door unlock detection switch circuit
DI–862
It is not canceled when the ignition key is turned to
ACC or ON position
Ignition switch circuit
DI–851
It still operates when the luggage compartment door is
opened with the key
Luggage compartment door key
lock and unlock switch circuit
DI–855
Door courtesy switch circuit
DI–864
Horns sound
Horn relay circuit
DI–845
Theft deterrent horn sounds
Theft deterrent horn circuit
DI–843
Headlights stay on
Headlight control relay circuit
DI–847
Taillights stay on
Taillight control relay circuit
DI–849
The theft deterrent system cannot be set
The indicator light does not blink when system is set
When the rear doors are unlocked
When the
system is
set
When the luggage compartment door is opened
by a method other than the key
When the engine hood is opened
While the system is Headlights do not flash
in warning operation
Taillights do not flash
The door lock is not locked in unlock condition
When the
system is
set
See page
System is still set even when a rear door is open
Even when the
system is not
set
The system
does not
operate
*1: If numbers are given to the circuit proceed with troubleshooting in the order indicated by those numbers.
Author:
Date:
1072
DI–838
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06S–04
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
Indicator Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is preparing to set, this circuit lights up the indicator light. When the system
has been set, it continuously turns the indicator light on for 1 second and turns it off for 1 second, thus blinking
the indicator light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Deterrent
Indicator Light
BR
5
Theft Deterrent ECU
Junction Connector
D R–Y 6
R–Y E
J10
J9
T3 IND
9
IH
I04447
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check indicator light.
PREPARATION:
Remove combination meter.
CHECK:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal C9 and the negative (–) lead to terminal B16 of
combination meter connector then check indicator light comes ON.
(See combination meter on page BE–46)
NG
Replace combination meter.
OK
Author:
Date:
1073
DI–839
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Check harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and indicator light,
indicator light and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.*1
*1: When there is a malfunction that the theft deterrent system
cannot be set, proceed to the next numbered circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–837).
Author:
Date:
1074
DI–840
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06T–06
ECU Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to operate the theft deterrent ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
E/G Room J/B No.2
1
2A
B
1
F6
SHORT PIN
DOME
12
2J
R
8 DIODE (DOME) E
1
2
J16
1G
R
R–Y
1
1W
4
1B
B–R
DOOR
1
1D
J/C D
11
J17
R
J34
J/C
Instrument Panel J/B
FL BLOCK
1
ALT
F9
1
Theft Deterrent ECU
Instrument Panel J/B
C
+B1
1
C
L–W
L–W
T4
T3
+B2
F4
7
B–G
A
FL MAIN
W–B
T3
E
J5
J/C
A
Battery
W–B
IF
I00238
Author:
Date:
1075
DI–841
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check DOME and DOOR fuses.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove DOME fuse from engine room junction block
No.2.
(b) Remove DOOR fuse from instrument panel junction block
No.1.
CHECK:
Check continuity of DOME and DOOR fuses.
OK:
Continuity
E/G room J/B No.2:
DOME Fuse
Instrument panel J/B:
DOOR Fuse
I00268
I00269
I00275
NG
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to the DOME and DOOR fuses
(See attached wiring diagram).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminals each of +B1 and +B2 and E of theft deterrent
ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the theft deterrent ECU connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals each of +B1 and +B2 and
E of theft deterrent ECU connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
+B1
(+)
+B2
(–)
E
I01922
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–837).
NG
Author:
Date:
1076
DI–842
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Check for open in harness and connector between ECU and body ground
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and repair harness and connector between ECU and battery.
Author:
Date:
1077
DI–843
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06V–06
Theft Deterrent Horn Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is activated, the relay in the ECU turns ON and OFF cycles of approximately
0.2 sec., causing the theft deterrent horn to blow (See the wiring diagram below).
In this condition, if any of the following operations is done, the relay in the ECU turns OFF, thus stopping
the theft deterrent horn from blowing:
(1) Unlock the front LH or RH door with key.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to ACC or ON position.
(3) Unlock the doors with the wireless door lock control system.
(4) Wait for approximately 60 seconds.
(5) Push the panic switch of the wireless door lock control system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
E/G Room J/B No.2
B–G
FL BLOCK
1
1
1
F4
2A
F6
B
HORN
Theft Deterrent ECU
HORN
2 1
3
2F
W
W–L
4
5
IK1
IG3
W–L
W–L
9
T3 SH
FL MAIN
Battery
I00261
Author:
Date:
1078
DI–844
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal 1 of theft deterrent horn connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the theft deterrent horn and disconnect the connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of theft deterrent horn
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
1
NG
I00294
Check and repair harness and connector between HORN fuse and theft deterrent horn.
OK
2
Check theft deterrent horn.
CHECK:
Connect positive (+) lead to terminal 1 and negative (–) lead to
terminal 2 to theft deterrent horn connector.
OK:
Theft deterrent horn blows.
1 (+)
2 (–)
I00295
NG
Replace theft deterrent horn.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and theft deterrent
horn (See page IN–29).
NG
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.
Author:
Date:
1079
DI–845
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06W–06
Horn Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is activated, it causes the Tr in the ECU to switch ON and OFF in approximately 0.4 sec. cycles. This switches the horn relay ON and OFF, thus the horns blow (See the wiring diagram below).
In this condition, if any of the following operations is done, the Tr in the ECU goes off and the horn relay
switches off, thus stopping the horns from blowing:
(1) Unlock the front LH or RH door with key.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to ACC or ON position.
(3) Unlock the doors with the wireless door lock control system.
(4) Wait for approximately 60 seconds.
(5) Push the panic switch of the wireless door lock control system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
E/G Room J/B No.2
HORN Relay
5
3
FL BLOCK
1
1
B–G
F4
F6
1
B
2A
HORN
1
2
1
Horn
G–W
1
2F
10
2K
Theft Deterrent ECU
J/C J2
C
C
G–B
G–B
11
IG1
12
G–B
T3
HORN
FL MAIN
Battery
I00262
Author:
Date:
1080
DI–846
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
The flow chart below is based on the premise that the horns blow normally whenever the horn switch is operated. If horn operation is not normal when the horn switch is operated, check the horn switch.
1
Check voltage between terminal HORN of theft deterrent ECU connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the theft deterrent ECU connectors.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal HORN of theft deterrent
ECU connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
HORN
I01923
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and horn relay.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.
Author:
Date:
1081
DI–847
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06X–06
Headlight Control Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is activated, it causes the Tr in the ECU to switch ON and OFF at approximately 0.4 sec. intervals. This switches the headlight control relay ON and OFF, thus flashing the headlights
(See the wiring diagram below).
In this condition, if any of the following operations is done, the Tr in the ECU goes OFF and the headlight
control relay switches OFF, thus stopping the headlights flashing:
(1) Unlock the front LH or RH door with key.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to ACC or ON position.
(3) Unlock the doors with the wireless door lock control system.
(4) Wait for approximately 60 seconds.
(5) Push the panic switch of the wireless door lock control system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
E/G Room J/B No.2
B
3
2B
MAIN
Headlight
Control Realy
4
1
3
8
2K
R–B*1
B
R–B*2
2
R*2
19
2
FL MAIN
B–G
B
Theft Deterrent ECU
7
10
R–B
IG3
T3 HEAD
Daytime Running
Light Relay
3 2G
FL BLOCK
1
1
F6
F4
J32*1
J6*2
J/C
R–B
Light Control Switch
(COMB. SW)*1
Daytime Running
Light Relay*2
Battery
*1: w/o Daytime Running Light
*2: w/ Daytime Running Light
I08428
Author:
Date:
1082
DI–848
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:The flow chart below is based on the premise that the headlights light up normally whenever the light
control switch is operated. If headlight operation is not normal when the light control switch is operated, proceed to troubleshooting on page BE–2.
1
Check voltage between terminal HEAD of theft deterrent ECU connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the theft deterrent ECU connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal HEAD of theft deterrent
ECU connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
HEAD
I01924
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and headlight control
relay (See page IN–31).
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.
Author:
Date:
1083
DI–849
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06Y–06
Taillight Control Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is activated, it causes the Tr in the ECU to switch ON and OFF at approximately 0.4 sec. intervals. This switches the taillight control relay ON and OFF, thus flashing the taillights (See
the wiring diagram below).
In this condition, if any of the following operations is done, the Tr in the ECU goes OFF and the taillight control
relay switches OFF, thus stopping the taillights flashing:
(1) Unlock the front LH or RH door with key.
(2) Turn the ignition switch to ACC or ON position.
(3) Unlock the doors with the wireless door lock control system.
(4) Wait for approximately 60 seconds.
(5) Push the panic switch of the wireless door lock control system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
J2
J/C
Taillight Control Relay
4
B–R
5
Light
F9
Sensor
9
BLOCK
1
A
G–R
A
G–R
10
IG1
B
G–R
B
G–R
11
T3
TAIL
3
1S
FL
ALT
6
1C
Theft Deterrent ECU
TAIL
8
Failure
1
2
1
1B
J33
J/C
1C
F4
Turn & Clearance
B–G
Light
FL MAIN
Battery
I00266
Author:
Date:
1084
DI–850
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
The flow chart below is based on the premise that the taillights light up normally whenever the light control
switch is operated. If taillight operation is not normal when the light control switch is operated, proceed to
troubleshooting on page BE–2.
1
Check voltage between terminal TAIL of theft deterrent ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the theft deterrent ECU connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal TAIL of theft deterrent ECU
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
TAIL
I01925
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and taillight control
relay (See page IN–31).
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.
Author:
Date:
1085
DI–851
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI06Z–06
Ignition Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned to the ACC position, battery positive voltage is applied to the terminal ACC
of the ECU. Also, if the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, battery positive voltage is applied to the
terminals ACC and IG of the ECU. When the battery positive voltage is applied to the terminal ACC of the
ECU while the theft deterrent system is activated, the warning stops. Furthermore, power supplied from the
terminals ACC and IG of the ECU is used as power for the door courtesy switch, and position switch, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
Theft Deterrent ECU
Ignition Switch
AM1
4 B–Y
2
1
ECU–IG
8
1D
1K
B–R
C
B
J16
J17
B–R
13
T4
IG
IG1
W
2
1K
AM1
1
1B
B–R
FL BLOCK
B–G
1
F4
ALT
1
F9
B–R
FL MAIN
Battery
I01927
Author:
Date:
1086
DI–852
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check CIG and ECU–IG fuses.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the fuse box opening cover.
(b) Remove ECU–IG fuses from instrument panel junction
block No.1.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuses.
OK:
Continuity
Instrument panel J/B:
ECU–IG Fuse
I00269
NG
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to the ECU–IG fuses (See attached wiring diagram).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminal IG of theft deterrent ECU and body ground.
(–)
(+)
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the theft deterrent ECU connectors.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal IG of theft deterrent ECU
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
IG
I01926
NG
Check and repair harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and battery
(See page IN–31).
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.
Author:
Date:
1087
DI–853
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI070–06
Key Unlock Warning Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The key unlock warning switch goes ON when the ignition key is inserted in the key cylinder and goes OFF
when the ignition key is removed.
The ECU operates the key confinement prevention function while the key unlock warning switch is ON.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Deterrent ECU
Key Unlock
Warning Switch
2
1
L–B
Instrument Panel J/B
5
1M
7
1D
L–B
B
J9
J/C B
J9
L–B
6
T4
KSW
W–B
Instrument Panel J/B
3
1M
7
1J
W–B
A
J11
J/C
IG
I08429
Author:
Date:
1088
DI–854
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check key unlock warning switch.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect key unlock warning switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal 1 and 2 of key unlock warning switch connector, when the key is inserted to the key cylinder or removed.
OK:
2 (–)
1 (+)
I00297
I00296
I00305
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
ON (Key inserted)
1–2
Continuity
OFF (Key removed)
–
No continuity
NG
Replace key unlock warning switch.
OK
2
Check harness and connectors between ECU and key unlock warning switch,
key unlock warning switch and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.*1
*1: When there is a malfunction that the theft deterrent system
cannot be set, proceed to the next numbered circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–837).
Author:
Date:
1089
DI–855
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI071–04
Luggage Compartment Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The luggage compartment door key lock and unlock switch goes ON when the luggage compartment door
key cylinder is turned to the unlock side with the key.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Deterrent ECU
Luggage Compartment
Door Key Lock and
Unlock Switch
1
J33
J/C
2
2
G–W
IF1
C
G–W
7
C
G–W
T4
LUG
W–B
BP
I00252
Author:
Date:
1090
DI–856
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal 1 of luggage compartment door key lock and
unlock switch connector and body ground.
ON
1
(–)
(+)
AB0119
I00271
I00277
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove luggage compartment door trim.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of luggage compartment
door key lock and unlock switch connector and body ground,
when the key is turned to the unlock side and not turned respectively.
OK:
OK
Key operation
Voltage
Turned to the unlock side
0V
Not turned
Battery positive voltage
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.*1
NG
2
Check luggage compartment door key lock and unlock switch.
2
PREPARATION:
Disconnect luggage compartment door key lock and unlock
switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals 1 and 2, when the key is
turned to the unlock side and not turned respectively.
OK:
1
I00270
Key operation
Tester connection
Specified condition
Turned to unlock
1–2
Continuity
Not turned
–
No continuity
NG
Repair or replace luggage compartment door
key lock and unlock switch.
OK
Author:
Date:
1091
DI–857
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Check harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and key lock and unlock switch, key lock and unlock switch and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.
*1: When there is a malfunction that the theft deterrent system
cannot be set, proceed to the next numbered circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–837).
Author:
Date:
1092
DI–858
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI072–06
Luggage compartment Door Courtesy Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The luggage compartment door courtesy switch goes ON when luggage compartment door is opened and
goes off when the luggage compartment door is closed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Deterrent ECU
R–Y
6
IF1
R–Y
2
T4
DSWL
1
Luggage Compartment
Door Courtesy Switch
I00253
Author:
Date:
1093
DI–859
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of luggage compartment door courtesy light.
CHECK:
Check that luggage compartment door courtesy light goes OFF when luggage compartment door courtesy
switch is pushed, and comes ON when switch is not pushed.
NG
Check and repair luggage compartment door
courtesy light circuit (See page BE–32).
OK
2
Check for open in harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and luggage compartment door courtesy switch (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connectors.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.*1
*1: When there is a malfunction that the theft deterrent system
cannot be set, proceed to the next numbered circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–837).
Author:
Date:
1094
DI–860
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI073–06
Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The door key lock and unlock switch is built in the door key cylinder. When the key is turned to the lock side,
terminal 1 of the switch is grounded and when the key is turned to the unlock side, terminal 2 of the switch
is grounded.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Door Key Lock and
Unlock Switch LH
20
IE1
J38
J/C
UNLOCK
A
W–B*1
A
1
W–B*1
LOCK
W–B
Theft Deterrent ECU
3
IE1
3
R–G
2
L–W
J6
J/C
B
R–G
B
R–G
B
B
L–W
4
IE1
L–W
9
T4 UL3
8
T4 L2
W–B*2
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1G
3
1V
W–B
J37
J/C
IE
Door Key Lock and
Unlock Switch RH
W–B
20
IM1
J39
J/C
A
W–B*1
LOCK
A
1
*1
W–B
3
UNLOCK
IJ
W–B*2
2
L–W
L
4
IM1
3
IM1
B
L–W
A
L
A
L
10
T4 UL2
*1: TMC Made
*2: TMMK Made
I08430
Author:
Date:
1095
DI–861
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check door key lock and unlock switch.
1
2
3
(+)
(–)
I00272
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the door trim and service hole cover.
(b) Disconnect the door key lock and unlock switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals 1, 2 and 3 of door key lock
and unlock switch connector, when each of door key lock and
unlock switch is turned to the lock side, unlock side and not
turned.
OK:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Lock side
2–3
Continuity
Unlock side
1–3
Continuity
OFF
–
No continuity
NG
Replace door key lock and unlock switch.
OK
2
Check harness and connectors between ECU and switch, switch and body
ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.*1
*1: When there is a malfunction that the theft deterrent system
cannot be set, proceed to the next numbered circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–837).
Author:
Date:
1096
DI–862
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI074–06
Door Unlock Detection Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The door unlock detection switch is built in the door lock motor assembly. This switch is ON when the door
lock knob is in the unlock position and OFF when the lock knob is in the lock position. The ECU detects the
door lock knob conditions in this circuit. It is used as one of the operating conditions for the key confinement
prevention function.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1G
3
1V
W
20
IE1
J38
J/C
A
W–B*1
W–B
Door Unlock Detection
Switch Front LH
11
A
1
4
IE1
W–B*1
L–R
Theft Deterrent ECU
J6
J/C
14
F
T4 LSWD
L–R
F
L–R
W–B*2
IE
W–B
IJ
20
IM1
J39
J/C
A
W–B*1
Door Unlock Detection
Switch Front RH *1
4
1*1
11
A
1*2
4*2
IM1
Y
W–B*1
J37
J/C
C
C
Y
Y
15
T4
LSWP
W–B*2
J40
J/C
A
W–B
Door Unlock Detection
Switch Rear LH
4
6
4
1
BO1
BO1
L–Y
W–B
L–Y
2
IF2
E
L–Y
J10
J/C
16
E
J10
L–Y
T4
LSWR
BL
W–B
W–B
Door Unlock Detection
Switch Rear RH
4
6
4
1
BP1
BP1
L–Y
W–B
D
3
L–Y
IN2
L–Y
J9
W–B
BN
IK
*1: TMC Made
*2: TMMK Made
I08431
Author:
Date:
1097
DI–863
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check Door Unlock Detection Switch.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the door trim and service hole cover.
(b) Disconnect door unlock detection switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals 1 and 4 of door unlock
detection switch connector, when the door lock knob is operated to the lock side and unlock side.
OK:
LOCK
UNLOCK
4
(–)
I00273
I00274
1
Switch Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Door unlock
1–4
Continuity
Door lock
–
No continuity
(+)
I00278
NG
Replace door unlock detection switch.
OK
2
Check harness and connectors between ECU and door unlock detection switch,
door unlock detection switch and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.*1
*1: When there is a malfunction that the theft deterrent system
cannot be set, proceed to the next numbered circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–837).
Author:
Date:
1098
DI–864
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI075–06
Door Courtesy Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The door courtesy switch goes ON when the door is opened and goes OFF when the door is closed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Deterrent ECU
Door Courtesy
Switch Front LH
Instrument panel J/B
J/C
R–G
1
7
1
1S
1G
Integration
A
C
J9
R–G
J10
R–G
4
T4
DSWD
R–W
1
T4
CTY
5
T4
DSWP
6
Relay
Door Courtesy
Switch Rear LH
R–B
1
J/C
4
12
1S
4
1G
R–W
D
J33
E
J34
Door Courtesy
Switch Rear RH
R–W
1
D
8
IN2
R–W
J33
D J33
R–W
1
Door Courtesy
Switch Front RH
R–G
1
Diode
J/C
6
IN2
R–G
D
J34
E
J33
2
R–G
E
J33
R–G
I04444
Author:
Date:
1099
DI–865
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of open door warning light.
CHECK:
Check that open door warning light comes ON when each door is opened, and goes OFF when all doors
are closed.
NG
Check and repair open door warning light circuit.
OK
2
Check for open in harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and door
courtesy switch (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU.*1
*1: When there is a malfunction that the theft deterrent system
cannot be set, proceed to the next numbered circuit inspection
shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–837).
Author:
Date:
1100
DI–866
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DI076–06
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The engine hood courtesy switch is built into the engine hood lock assembly and goes ON when the engine
hood is opened and goes OFF when the engine hood is closed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Theft Deterrent ECU
Engine Hood Courtesy
Switch
2
W–B
1
B
3
IK1
B
1
IG3
B
3
T3
DSWH
EB
I00257
Author:
Date:
1101
DI–867
DIAGNOSTICS
–
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check engine hood courtesy switch.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove engine hood lock assembly.
(b) Disconnect engine hood courtesy switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals 1 and 2 when engine hood
lock is locked and unlocked.
OK:
1 (+)
2 (–)
Engine hood lock
Tester connection
Specified condition
LOCK
–
No continuity
UNLOCK
1–2
Continuity
I00298
NG
Replace engine hood courtesy switch.
OK
2
Check harness and connector between theft deterrent ECU and switch, switch
and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace theft deterrent ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1102
DI–868
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08F–11
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following page.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Items inside
are titles of pages in this
manual with the page number indicated in the
bottom portion.
See the indicated pages
for detailed explanations.
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–869
2
Check and Clear DTC (Precheck)
P. DI–870
Symptom does not occur
3
4
Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
Symptom occurs
5
Normal code
DTC Check
P. DI–870
Malfunction code
6
7
DTC Chart
Problem Symptoms Table
P. DI–879
P. DI–875
9
8
Circuit Inspection
Input Signal Check
Parts Inspection
P. DI–881
Identification of Problem
Repair
NG
10
Confirmation Test
OK
Step 2, 5: Diagnostic steps permitting the use
of the TOYOTA hand–held tester or
TOYOTA break–out–box.
End
Author:
Date:
1103
DI–869
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08G–08
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
Date of Problem
Occurrence
Condition of
How Often does
Problem Occurrence Problem Occurs
/
Continuous
Symptoms
/
Intermittent (
Vehicle Speed when
Problem Occurred
Auto cancel
occurs
km
Mile
Odometer Reading
Times a day)
km
Mile
Driving condition
City driving
Freeway
Up hill
Down hill
After cancel occurred, did the driver activate cruise control
again?
Yes
No
Cancel does not
occur
With brake ON
Except D position shift At 40 km/h (25 mph) or less
When control SW turns to CANCEL position
Cruise control
malfunction
Slip to acceleration side
Slip to deceleration side
Hunting occurs
O/D cut off does not occur
O/D does not return
Switch
malfunction
SET
ACCEL
COAST RESUME
CANCEL
Remains ON
Does not light up
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
DTC Check
Author:
Date:
Blinking
1104
DI–870
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI1KS–03
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light
I00279
HINT:
If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to troubleshooting (See page BE–2) for the combination meter section.
(b) Check the DTC.
HINT:
If a malfunction occurs in the No. 1 vehicle speed sensor or actuator, etc. during cruise control driving, the ECU actuates
AUTO CANCEL of the cruise control and turns on and off the
CRUISE MAIN indicator light to inform the driver of a malfunction. At the same time, the malfunction is stored in memory as
a DTC.
Indicator light
1.5 sec.
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Check the indicator.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Check that the CRUISE MAIN indicator light comes
ON when the cruise control main switch is turned
ON, and that the indicator light goes OFF when the
main switch is turned OFF.
0.5 sec.
ON
OFF
BE4034
(c)
DLC2
Tc
Output of DTC using diagnosis check wire.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Read the DTC on the CRUISE MAIN indicator light.
E1
I00169
Author:
Date:
1105
DI–871
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
If the DTC is not output, inspect the diagnosis circuit (See page
DI–916).
As an example, the blinking patterns for codes; normal, 11 and
21 are shown in the illustration.
Normal code
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
Malfunction codes 11 and 21
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec. 2.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
ON
OFF
BE4032
BE4033
Code 11
Code 21
I00021
2.
(a)
(b)
H07517
(b)
E1
(d) 5 times
within 3 seconds
DLC1
TC
(c)
I08438
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC2.
Monitor the ECU data by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” function which records the monitored data.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
3.
DTC CLEARANCE (ERASE MODE)
HINT:
During in the erase mode, diag detection does not work.
(a) Stop the vehicle.
(b) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(c) Pull the cruise control switch to CANCEL.
(d) On the above metioned condition, turn on the cruise control main switch 5 times within 3 seconds.
Author:
Date:
1106
DI–872
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
(a)
N17520
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CHECK
(ROAD TEST)
Inspect the SET switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) Press the control switch to the SET/COAST.
(4) After releasing the switch, check that the vehicle
cruises at the desired speed.
(b)
Inspect the ACCEL switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) Check that the vehicle speed increases while the
control switch is turned to RES/ACC, and that the
vehicle cruises at the set speed when the switch is
released.
(4) Momentarily raise the control switch upward to the
RES/ACC position and then immediately release it.
Check that the vehicle speed increases by approx.
1.5 km/h (Tap–up function).
(c)
Inspect the COAST switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) Check that the vehicle speed decreases while the
control switch is turned to SET/COAST, and the vehicle cruises at the set speed when the switch is released.
(4) Momentarily pull the control switch down to SET/
COAST, and then immediately release it. Check
that the vehicle speed decreases by about 1.5 km/h
(Tap–down function).
N17520
N17520
–
Author:
Date:
1107
DI–873
DIAGNOSTICS
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
Inspect the CANCEL switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) When operating one of the following operations,
check that the cruise control system is cancelled
and that the normal driving mode is reset.
Depress the brake pedal
Depress the clutch pedal (M/T)
Shift to except D position (A/T)
Push the main switch OFF
Pull the cruise control switch to CANCEL
(e)
Inspect the RESUME switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) When operating one of the following operations
check that the cruise control system is cancelled
and that the normal driving mode is reset.
Depress the brake pedal
Depress the clutch pedal (M/T)
Shift to except D position (A/T)
Push the main switch OFF
Pull the cruise control switch to CANCEL
(4) After the control switch is turned to RES/ACC at the
driving speed of more than 40 km/h (25 mph), check
that the vehicle restores the speed prior to the cancellation.
N17520
N17520
–
Author:
Date:
1108
DI–874
DIAGNOSTICS
(1)
(2)
(1)
No.
N17520
–
5.
INPUT SIGNAL CHECK
HINT:
(1) For check No.1 ∼ No.3
Turn ignition switch ON.
(2) For check No.4
Jack up the vehicle.
Start the engine.
Shift to D position.
(a) Pull the control switch to SET/COAST or RES/ACC position and hold it down or up (1).
(b) Push the main switch ON (2).
(c) Check that the CRUISE MAIN indicator light blinks twice
or 3 times repeatedly after 3 seconds.
(d) Turn the SET/COAST or RES/ACC switch OFF.
(e) Operate each switch as listed in the table below.
(f)
Read the blinking pattern of the CRUISE MAIN indicator
light.
(g) After performing the check, turn the main switch OFF.
HINT:
When 2 or more signals are input to the ECU, the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Operation Method
0.25 sec.
1
Turn SET/COAST switch ON
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Light
ON
0.25 sec.
SET/COAST switch circuit
is normal
1sec.
OFF
ON
2
Turn RES/ACC switch ON
Light
RES/ACC switch circuit
is normal
OFF
Turn CANCEL switch ON
ON
Switch ON
OFF
Turn stop light switch ON
Depress brake pedal
Turn PNP switch OFF
(Shift to except D position)
ON
Light
OFF
Turn clutch switch OFF
(Depress clutch pedal)
Drive at about 40 km/h
(25 mph)or higher
Light
Drive at about 40 km/h
(25 mph) or below
Light
4
CANCEL switch circuit
is normal
Switch OFF
Light
3
Diagnosis
Stop light switch circuit
is normal
PNP switch circuit is
normal
Switch ON
Switch OFF
Clutch switch circuit
is normal
ON
OFF
Vehicle Speed Sensor is
normal
ON
OFF
Author:
Date:
1109
DI–875
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08I–08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table
below and proceed to the appropriate page.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Circuit Inspection
Trouble Area
Actuator Motor Circuit
Actuator motor
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
actuator motor
Cruise control ECU
12
(DI–883)
Actuator Magnetic Clutch Circuit
STOP Fuse
Stop light switch
Actuator magnetic clutch
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
actuator magnetic clutch, actuator magnetic clutch and body
ground
Cruise control ECU
14
(DI–886)
Actuator Mechanical Malfunction
Actuator motor (actuator lock: motor, arm)
Cruise control ECU
21
(DI–888)
Open in Vehicle Speed Sensor Circuit
Combination meter
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and combination meter, combination meter and vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor
Cruise control ECU
23
(DI–891)
Vehicle Speed Signal Abnormal
Vehicle speed sensor
Cruise control ECU
Control Switch Circuit
Cruise control switch
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and cruise
control switch, cruise control switch and body ground
Cruise control ECU
41
Cruise control ECU
Cruise control ECU
42
Source voltage drop
Power source
Idle Signal Circuit
Throttle position sensor
Harness or connector between ECM and throttle position
sensor
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and ECM
Cruise control ECU
11, 15
(DI–881)
32
(DI–892)
51
(DI–895)
Author:
Date:
1110
DI–876
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08J–08
PARTS LOCATION
Cruise Control Actuator
Actuator Motor
Actuator Magnetic Clutch
Cruise Control switch
Main Switch
Control Switch
Stop Light Switch
Cruise Control ECU
Instrument Panel Junction Block No.1
ECU–IG Fuse
STOP Fuse
DLC2
5S–FE engine:
1MZ–FE engine:
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Park/Neutral Position Switch
I08439
Author:
Date:
1111
DI–877
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI1KT–06
TERMINALS OF ECU
C15
I00293
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
STP ↔ GND
STP–
(C15–2 ↔ C15–16)
G W ↔ W–B
G–W
W B
D ↔ GND (C15–3
(C15 3 ↔ C15–16)
C15 16)
B R ↔ W–B
B–R
W B
PI ↔ GND (C15–4
(C15 4 ↔ C15–16)
C15 16)
TC ↔ GND
(C15–5 ↔ C15–16)
ECT ↔ GND
(C15–6 ↔ C15–16)
O ↔ W–B
W B
LG–R ↔ W–B
L B ↔ W–B
L–B
W B
MC ↔ GND
(C15–7 ↔ C15–16)
R B ↔ W–B
R–B
W B
L ↔ GND
(C15–8 ↔ C15–16)
G B ↔ W–B
G–B
W B
B ↔ GND
(C15–9 ↔ C15–16)
B–R ↔ W–B
CCS ↔ GND
(C15–10 ↔ C15–16)
W ↔ W–B
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
Depress brake pedal
10 – 16 V
Release brake pedal
Below 1 V
Shift to positions except D
Below 1 V
Shift to D position
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
Cruise control main switch ON
Below 1.2 V
Ignition switch ON
Cruise control main switch OFF
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
Connect terminals Tc and E1 of diagnostic check connector
Below 1 V
During driving
Gear position 3rd
10 – 16 V
During driving
Gear position O/D
Below 1 V
During cruise control driving
COAST switch held ON
9 – 15 V
During cruise control driving
ACC switch held ON
Below 1 V
During cruise control driving
9 – 15 V
Except during cruise control driving
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
CANCEL switch held ON
4.2 – 8.8 V
Ignition switch ON
SET/COAST switch held ON
2.5 – 6.3 V
Ignition switch ON
RES/ACC switch held ON
0.8 – 3.7 V
Author:
Date:
1112
DI–878
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
W L ↔ W–B
W–L
W B
SPD ↔ GND
(C15 12 ↔ C15–16)
(C15–12
C15 16)
V–W
V
W↔W
W–B
B
OD ↔ GND
(C15–14 ↔ C15–16)
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Wiring Color
CMS ↔ GND
(C15–11 ↔ C15–16)
IDL ↔ GND
(C15–13 ↔ C15–16)
–
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
Ignition switch ON
Main switch OFF
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
Main switch ON
Below 0.5 V
Engine start
Car stoppage.
Below 1.5 V or
4.7 – 16 V
During driving (Pulse generated).
L R ↔ W–B
L–R
W B
Y B ↔ W–B
Y–B
W B
MO ↔ GND
(C15–15 ↔ C15–16)
R G ↔ W–B
R–G
W B
GND ↔ Body Ground
(C15–16 ↔ Body Ground)
W–B ↔ Body
Ground
3–7V
Ignition switch ON
Throttle valve fully opened.
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
Throttle valve fully closed.
Below 1.5 V
During cruise control driving
OD switch ON.
10 – 16 V
During cruise control driving
OD switch OFF (3rd driving)
Below 1 V
During cruise control driving
ACC switch hold ON
9 – 15 V
During cruise control driving
COAST switch hold ON
Below 1 V
Constant
Below 1 V
Author:
Date:
1113
DI–879
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08L–13
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
See pageSee
page
Suspect AreaSuspect Area
SET not occourring or CANCEL occurring.
(DTC is Normal)
3. Main Switch Circuit
(Cruise control switch)
4. Vehicle Speed Sensor
5. Control Switch Circuit
(Cruise control switch)
6. Stop Light Switch Circuit
7. Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
8. Clutch Switch
9. Actuator Motor Circuit
10.Cruise Control Cable
11.Cruise Control ECU
SET not occurring or CANCEL occurring.
(DTC dose not output)
1. ECU Power Source Circuit
2. Cruise Control ECU
DI–909
IN–31
DI–918
DI–891
Actual vehicle speed deviates above or below the set speed.
1. Cruise Control Cable
2. Vehicle Speed Signal Abnormal
3. Electronically Controlled Transmission
Communication Circuit
4. Actuator Motor Circuit
5. Idle Signal Circuit
(Main throttle position sensor)
6. Cruise Control ECU
DI–912
DI–888
DI–892
DI–898
DI–904
DI–907
DI–881
DI–918
IN–31
DI–901
DI–881
DI–895
IN–31
Gear shifting frequent between 3rd O/D when driving on uphill
road. (Hurting)
1. Electronically Controlled Transmission
Communication Circuit
2. Cruise Control ECU
DI–901
IN–31
Cruise control not cancelled, even when brake pedal is depressed.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Stop Light Switch Circuit
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–918
DI–898
DI–881
IN–31
Cruise control not cancelled, even when transmission is shifted to
”N” postion.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–918
DI–904
DI–881
IN–31
Cruise control not cancelled, even when clutch pedal is depressed.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Clutch Switch Circuit
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–918
DI–907
DI–881
IN–31
Control switch does not operate.
(SET/COAST, ACC/RES, CANCEL not possible)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Control Switch Circuit
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–918
DI–892
DI–881
IN–31
SET possible at 40 km/h (25 mph) or less, or CANCEL does not
operate at 40 km/h (25 mph) or less.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Vehicle Speed Signal Abnormal
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–918
DI–891
DI–881
IN–31
Poor response is in ACCEL and RESUME modes.
1. Cruise Control Cable
2. Electronically Controlled Transmission
Communication Circuit
3. Actuator Motor Circuit
4. Cruise Control ECU
O/D does not resume, even though the road is not uphill.
1. Electronically Controlled Transmission
Communication Circuit
2. Cruise Control ECU
Author:
DI–918
DI–901
DI–881
IN–31
DI–901
IN–31
Date:
1114
DI–880
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC memory is erased.
1. Cruise Control ECU
IN–31
DTC is not output, or is output when should not be.
1. Diagnosis Circuit
2. Cruise Control ECU
DI–916
IN–31
Cruise MAIN indicator light remains ON or falls to light up.
1. Cruise MAIN Indicator Light Switch Circuit
DI–914
Author:
Date:
1115
DI–881
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08M–12
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
11, 15
Actuator Motor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The actuator motor is operated by signals from the ECU. Acceleration and deceleration signals are transmitted according to changes in the Duty Ratio (See below).
Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle. For example, if A is the period of continuity
in one cycle, and B is the period of non–continuity.
A
A
Duty Ratio =
A+B
DTC No.
ON
x 100 (%)
OFF
B
1 cycle
Detection Item
Trouble Area
11
Short in actuator motor circuit.
Actuator motor
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
actuator motor
Cruise control ECU
15
Open in actuator motor circuit.
Actuator motor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
Cruise Control Actuator
Actuator Motor
7
2
C15
R–B
MC
15
1
C15
MO
R–G
I00280
Author:
Date:
1116
DI–882
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check resistance between terminals MO and MC of actuator motor.
ON
2
1
I00004
I00151
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch ON.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2.
HINT:
If control plate is in fully opened or fully closed positions, resistance can not be measured.
OK:
Resistance: more than 4.2 Ω
NG
Replace cruise control actuator.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connectors between cruise control
ECU and actuator motor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1117
DI–883
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08N–12
DTC
12
Actuator Magnetic Clutch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit turns on the magnetic clutch inside the actuator during cruise control operation according to the
signal from the ECU. If a malfunction occurs in the actuator or speed sensor, etc. during cruise control operation, the rotor shaft between the motor and control plate is released.
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stop light switch turns on, supplying electrical power to the stop light.
Power supply to the magnetic clutch is mechanically cut and the magnetic clutch is turned OFF.
When driving downhill, if the vehicle speed exceeds the set speed by 15 km/h (9 mph), the ECU turns the
safety magnet clutch OFF. If the vehicle speed later drops to within 10 km/h (6 mph), cruise control at the
set speed is resumed.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
STOP Fuse
Stop light switch
Actuator magnetic clutch
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
actuator magnetic clutch, actuator magnetic clutch and body
ground
Cruise control ECU
Short in actuator magnetic clutch circuit.
Open (0.8 sec.) in actuator magnetic clutch circuit.
12
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
A
J7
J/C
Cruise Control Actuator
Actuator Magnetic Clutch
A
J7
4
W–B
3
R–Y
Stop Light Switch
4
3
1
2
8
C15
G–B
L
W–B
8
1J
Instrument
Panel J/B
7
1J
Stop Lights
STOP Fuse
W–B
A
J11
J/C
IG
I00281
Author:
Date:
1118
DI–884
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check STOP fuse.
Instrument panel junction block No.1:
STOP Fuse
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(b) Remove the STOP fuse from instrument panel junction
block No.1.
CHECK:
Check fuse continuity.
OK:
There is continuity.
I00157
NG
Replace STOP fuse.
OK
2
Check stop light switch.
2
4
1
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the stop light switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals.
3
I00133
NG
Switch position
Continuity
Switch pin free
(Brake pedal depressed)
1–2
Switch pin pushed in
(Brake pedal released)
3–4
Replace stop light switch.
OK
Author:
Date:
1119
DI–885
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check resistance between terminals L and GND of actuator magnetic clutch.
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and 4.
OK:
Resistance: 34.65 – 42.35 Ω.
4
3
I00311
NG
Replace cruise control actuator.
OK
4
Check for open and short in harness and connectors between cruise control
ECU and actuator magnetic clutch, actuator magnetic clutch and body ground
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1120
DI–886
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08O–12
DTC
14
Actuator Mechanical Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit detects the rotation position of the actuator control plate and sends a signal to the ECU.
DTC No.
14
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Cruise control actuator mechanical malfunction.
Actuator lock: (motor, arm)
Actuator motor
Cruise control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–881.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check cruise control actuator arm locking operation
4
(+)
(–)
3
I00055
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
CHECK:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the terminal 3
of actuator and the negative (–) lead to terminal 4.
NOTICE:
Do not connect the high tension cables to the wrong battery terminal. The cruise control actuator will be damaged.
Move the control plate by hand.
OK:
Control plate doesn’t move.
NG
Replace cruise control actuator.
OK
Author:
Date:
1121
DI–887
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check cruise control actuator operation.
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
CHECK:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminals 1 and
3 of actuator, connect the negative (–) lead to terminals 2 and
4 of actuator.
OK:
Control arm moves to fully open side
Fully open side
4
1
3
2
Control plate
CHECK:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminals 2 and
3 of actuator, connect the negative (–) lead to terminals 1 and
4 of actuator.
OK:
Control arm moves to fully colsed side
Fully Closed side
4
1
3 2
Control plate
I08437
NG
Replace cruise control actuator.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and cruise control actuator (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1122
DI–888
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08P–12
DTC
21
Open in Vehicle Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The signal from the vehicle speed sensor circuit is sent to cruise control ECU as vehicle speed signal.
The rotor shaft is driven by the gear of the transmission.
For each rotation of the shaft, the vehicle speed sensor sends a 4–pulse signal through the combination
meter to the cruise control ECU (See the following installation).
This signal is converted inside the combination meter and sent as a 4–pulse signal to the cruise control ECU.
The ECU calculates the vehicle speed from this pulse frequency.
4 pulses/
4 pulses/
1 rotation
1 rotation
of rotor shaft
of rotor shaft
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Combination Meter
ECU
DTC No.
21
Cruise Control ECU
Detection Item
I00292
Trouble Area
Speed signal is not input to the cruise control ECU while cruise
control is set.
Combination meter
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and combination meter, combination meter and vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor
Cruise control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
Combination Meter
15
C9
L
P
7
2
IJ1
14
3
C9
IG3
V–W
B
V–W
12
B
C15
V–W
SPD
6
IJ1
L
3
SI
C10
Speedo
–meter
J15
J/C
P
2
SE
Speed
Sensor
IG+
1
to GAUGE Fuse
R–L
I00282
Author:
Date:
1123
DI–889
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Input signal check.
Input Signal
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Drive at about
40 km/h (25 mph)
or below
Light
Drive at about
40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher
Light ON
OFF
ON
OFF
CHECK:
(a) See input signal check on page DI–870.
(b) Check indicator light operation when driving with vehicle
speed above 40 km/h (25 mph), and with vehicle speed
below 40 km/h (25 mph).
OK:
Vehicle speed above 40 km/h (25 mph):
Indicator light blinks
Vehicle speed below 40 km/h (25 mph):
Indicator light stays on
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
NG
2
Check speedometer circuit (See Combination meter troubleshooting on page
BE–2).
NG
Repair or replace harness, connector or combination meter assembly.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and combination meter, combination meter and vehicle speed sensor (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Author:
Date:
1124
DI–890
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check vehicle speed sensor (See page BE–47).
NG
Replace vehicle speed sensor.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1125
DI–891
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08Q–10
DTC
23
Vehicle Speed Signal Abnormal
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
See page DI–888.
DTC No.
23
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Vehicle speed sensor
Cruise control ECU
Vehicle speed sensor pulse is abnormal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–888.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check vehicle speed sensor (See page BE–47).
NG
Replace vehicle speed sensor.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1126
DI–892
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08R–12
DTC
32
Control Switch Circuit (Cruise Control
Switch)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit carries the SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL and CANCEL signals (each voltage) to the ECU.
DTC No.
32
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Cruise control switch
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
cruise control switch, cruise control switch and body ground
Cruise control ECU
Short in control switch circuit.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control Switch
Main Switch
Control Switch
MAIN
Cruise Control ECU
11
CMS 5
C15
W–L
CANCEL
CMS
SET/COAST
RES/ACC
3 EP
10
CCS 4
C15
W
A
J7
W–B
J11
J/C
Instrument Panel J/B
A
W–B
7
8
1J
1J
A
J/C
CCS
A
J8
16
C15
W–B
GND
J7
W–B
IG
I00283
Author:
Date:
1127
DI–893
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Input signal check.
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Input Signal
SET/COAST
switch
2 Pulses
ON
OFF
RESUME/ACCEL
switch
OFF
ON
CANCEL switch
3 Pulses
ON
SW OFF
OFF
SW ON
PREPARATION:
See input signal check on page DI–870.
CHECK:
Check the indicator light operation when each of the SET/
COAST, RESUME/ACCEL and CANCEL is turned on.
OK:
SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL switch
The signals shown in the table on the left should be
output when each switch is ON. The signal should
disappear when the switch is turned OFF.
CANCEL switch
The indicator light goes off when the cancel switch is
turned ON.
OK
Wait and see.
NG
2
Check voltage between terminals CCS of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals 18 of ECU connector and
body ground, when each of the SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL and CANCEL is turned ON.
ON
CCS
(–)
(+)
AB0119
I00168
I00171
NG
Switch position
Resistance (V)
Neutral
10 – 16 V
RES/ACC
0.8 – 3.7 V
SET/COAST
2.5 – 6.3 V
CANCEL
4.2 – 8.8 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
OK
Author:
Date:
1128
DI–894
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check control switch.
4
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove steering wheel center pad.
(b) Disconnect the control switch connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and 4 of control switch
connector when control switch is operated.
3
N16045
NG
Switch position
Resistance (Ω)
Neutral
∞ (No continuity)
RES/ACC
50 – 80
SET/COAST
180 – 220
CANCEL
400 – 440
Replace control switch.
OK
4
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and cruise control switch,
cruise control switch and body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Wait and see.
OK
5
Input signal check (See step 1).
NG
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1129
DI–895
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08S–10
DTC
51
Idle Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the idle switch is turned ON, a signal is sent to the ECU. The ECU uses this signal to correct the discrepancy between the throttle valve position and the actuator position sensor value to enable accurate
cruise control at the set speed. If the idle switch is malfunctioning, problem symptoms also occur in the engine, so also inspect the engine.
DTC No.
51
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Harness or connector between ECM and throttle position
sensor
Throttle position sensor
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and ECM
Cruise control ECU
Short in idle signal circuit.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Cruise Control ECU
1
2
3* 4 *
E7 E8
IDL
13
C15
L–R
IDL
*1: 5S–FE Engine
*2: 1MZ–FE Engine
I00284
Author:
Date:
1130
DI–896
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal IDL of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Disconnect the ECM connector.
(c) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal IDL of ECU connector and
body ground when the throttle valve is fully closed and fully
opened.
OK:
ON
IDL
(–)
AB0119
I00167
(+)
I00172
OK
Throttle valve position
Voltage
Fully opened
10 – 14 V
Fully closed
Below 2 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
2
Check harness and connector between ECM and throttle position sensor
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check throttle position sensor circuit (See page DI–243).
NG
Replace throttle position sensor.
OK
Author:
Date:
1131
DI–897
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check throttle position sensor.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and 4 of throttle position sensor connector when the throttle valve is fully closed and
fully opened.
OK:
Throttle Position Sensor
3
4
I00052
NG
Throttle valve position
Resistance
Fully opened
1 MΩ or higher
Fully closed
Below 2.3 kΩ
Replace throttle position sensor.
OK
5
Check for open and short in harness and connector between cruise control ECU
and ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1132
DI–898
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08T–11
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stop light switch sends a signal to the ECU. When the ECU receives
this signal, it cancels the cruise control.
A fail–safe function is provided so that the cancel functions normally, even if there is a malfunction in the stop
light signal circuit.
The cancel conditions are: Battery positive voltage at terminal STP–
When the brake is ON, battery positive voltage normally is applied through the STOP fuse and stop light
switch to terminal STP– of the ECU, and the ECU turns the cruise control OFF.
If the harness connected to terminal STP– has an open circuit, terminal STP– will have battery positive voltage and the cruise control will be turned OFF.
Also, when the brake is ON, the magnetic clutch circuit is cut mechanically by the stop light switch, turning
the cruise control OFF. (See page DI–883 for operation of the magnetic clutch)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
Stop Light Switch
Instrument Panel J/B
2
1
G–W
3
J27
J/C
5
1R
4
1R
A
G–W
2
A
G–W
C15
STP–
4
R–Y
8
W
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1C
STOP
4
1B
1
F4
B–G
ALT
A
J7
B–R
FL BLOCK
1
F9
C15
G–B
J/C
L
Cruise Control
Actuator
A
J7
3
4
W–B
W–B
Instrument Panel J/B
8
1J
7
1J
J11
J/C
A
W–B
FL MAIN
Battery
IG
I00285
Author:
Date:
1133
DI–899
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of stop light.
CHECK:
Check that stop light comes ON when brake pedal is depressed, and turns OFF when brake pedal is released.
NG
Check stop light system (See page BE–2).
OK
2
Input signal check.
Input Signal
Stop Light
switch ON
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
OFF
Light
ON
SW OFF
SW ON
CHECK:
(a) See input signal check on DI–870.
(b) Check the indicator light when the brake pedal is depressed.
OK:
The indicator light goes OFF when the brake pedal is
depressed.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
Author:
Date:
1134
DI–900
DIAGNOSTICS
3
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal STP– of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connectors still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal STP– of cruise control ECU
connector and body ground, when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
OK:
ON
STP–
(–)
(+)
OK
AB0119
I00142
–
Depressed
10 – 14 V
Released
Below 1 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
I00173
NG
4
Check for open in harness and connectors between terminal STP– of cruise control ECU and stop light switch (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1135
DI–901
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08U–11
Electronically Controlled Transmission Communication Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When driving uphill under the cruise control, in order to reduce shifting due to ON–OFF overdrive operation
and to provide smooth driving, when down shifting in the electronically controlled transmission occurs, a signal to prevent upshift until the end of the uphill slope is sent from the cruise control ECU to the electronically
controlled transmission.
Terminal ECT of the cruise control ECU detects the shift change signal (output to electronically controlled
transmission No. 2 solenoid) from the ECM.
If the vehicle speeds down, also when terminal ECT of the cruise control ECU receives down shifting signal,
it sends a signal from terminal OD to ECM to cut overdrive until the end of the uphill slope, and the gear shifts
are reduced and gear shift points in the electronically controlled transmission are changed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
*1: 1MZ–FE
*2: 5S–FE (w/ Immobiliser)
*3: 5S–FE (w/o Immobiliser)
ECM
OD1
24 18 20
E8 E7 E7
*1
S2
*2
*2
14 OD
C15
Y–B
*3
8
21 6
E11 E9 E9
*1
Cruise Control ECU
*3
J26*1
J25*2
J/C
L–B
L–B
A
A
7
II2
L–B
6 ECT
C15
A
ECT No.2
Solenoid
I08432
Author:
Date:
1136
DI–902
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of overdrive.
PREPARATION:
Test drive after engine warms up.
CHECK:
Check that overdrive ON ↔ OFF occurs by operation of OD switch ON–OFF.
NG
Check and repair electronically controlled
transmission (See page DI–389).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminal OD of harness side connector of cruise control
ECU and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
(c) Disconnect the ECU connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal OD of harness side connector of ECU and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
O/D
(–)
(+)
AB0119
I00143
I00174
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
Author:
Date:
1137
DI–903
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal ECT of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground (On test drive).
(–)
(+)
ECT
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the ECU connector.
(b) Test drive after engine warms up.
CHECK:
Check voltage between terminal ECT of ECU connector and
body ground when OD switch is ON and OFF.
OK:
I00141
OK
OD switch position
Voltage
ON
8 – 14 V
OFF
Below 0.5 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
4
Check harness and connector between terminal ECT of cruise control ECU and
electronically controlled transmission solenoid (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
5
Check harness and connector between terminal OD of cruise control ECU and
terminal OD1 of ECM (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1138
DI–904
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08V–11
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the shift position is except D, a signal is sent from the park/neutral position switch to the ECU. When
this signal is input during cruise control driving, the ECU cancels the cruise control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
For M/T
Instrument Panel J/B
1
1K
1
GAUGE
1J
F
J28
R–L
J/C
D
J27
J29
J/C
Clutch Switch
2
1
A
B–R
R–L
A
F J28
B–Y
Ignition Switch
4
R–L
2
Instrument Panel J/B
For A/T
AM1
II2
W
2
1K
R–L
II2
A
A
2
ALT
1
F4
10
B–R
J/C
J21 (5S–FE)
J24 (1MZ–FE)
FL BLOCK
1
F9
9
PNP Switch
R–L
B–R
D
AM1 2
IG1
1
1B
3
A
C15
B–R
B–G
FL MAIN
Battery
I08433
Author:
Date:
1139
DI–905
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check starter operation.
CHECK:
Check that the starter operates normally and that the engine starts.
NG
Proceed to engine troubleshooting.
(5S–FE: See page ST–1)
(1MZ–FE: See page ST–1).
OK
2
Input signal check.
Input Signal
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Turn PNP switch
ON SW ON
OFF (Shift to posi- Light
SW OFF
tions except D )
OFF
PREPARATION:
See input signal check on page DI–870.
CHECK:
Check the indicator light when shifting into positions except D.
OK:
The indicator light goes off when shifting into positions except D.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
Author:
Date:
1140
DI–906
DIAGNOSTICS
3
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal D of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal D of ECU connector and
body ground when shifting into D position and other positions.
OK:
ON
D
(–)
AB0119
I00139
–
Shift Position
Voltage
D position
10 – 14 V
Other positions
Below 1 V
(+)
I00175
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
4
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and park/neutral
position switch (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1141
DI–907
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08W–04
Clutch Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the clutch pedal is depressed, the clutch switch sends a signal to the cruise control ECU. When the
signal is input to the cruise control ECU during cruise control driving, the cruise control ECU cancels cruise
control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to PNP switch circuit on page DI–904.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check starter operation.
CHECK:
Check that the starter operates normally and that the engine starts.
NG
Proceed to engine troubleshooting
(5S–FE: See page ST–1)
(1MZ–FE: See page ST–1).
OK
2
Input signal check.
Input Signal
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Clutch switch
ON SW ON
OFF (Depress Light
SW OFF
clutch pedal)
OFF
PREPARATION:
See input signal check on page DI–870.
CHECK:
Check the indicator lights when clutch pedal is depressed.
OK:
The indicator light goes off when shifting into clutch
pedal is depressed.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
Author:
Date:
1142
DI–908
DIAGNOSTICS
3
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal D of cruise control ECU and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal D of cruise control ECU connector and body ground when clutch pedal is depressed and
pushed in.
OK:
ON
D
(–)
AB0119
I00139
–
(+)
Shift Position
Voltage
Clutch pedal depressed
10 – 14 V
Clutch pedal pushed in
Below 1 V
I00175
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
4
Check for open in harness and connector between ECU and GAUGE fuse
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1143
DI–907
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08W–04
Clutch Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the clutch pedal is depressed, the clutch switch sends a signal to the cruise control ECU. When the
signal is input to the cruise control ECU during cruise control driving, the cruise control ECU cancels cruise
control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to PNP switch circuit on page DI–904.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check starter operation.
CHECK:
Check that the starter operates normally and that the engine starts.
NG
Proceed to engine troubleshooting
(5S–FE: See page ST–1)
(1MZ–FE: See page ST–1).
OK
2
Input signal check.
Input Signal
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Clutch switch
ON SW ON
OFF (Depress Light
SW OFF
clutch pedal)
OFF
PREPARATION:
See input signal check on page DI–870.
CHECK:
Check the indicator lights when clutch pedal is depressed.
OK:
The indicator light goes off when shifting into clutch
pedal is depressed.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
Author:
Date:
1142
DI–908
DIAGNOSTICS
3
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal D of cruise control ECU and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal D of cruise control ECU connector and body ground when clutch pedal is depressed and
pushed in.
OK:
ON
D
(–)
AB0119
I00139
–
(+)
Shift Position
Voltage
Clutch pedal depressed
10 – 14 V
Clutch pedal pushed in
Below 1 V
I00175
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
4
Check for open in harness and connector between ECU and GAUGE fuse
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1143
DI–909
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08X–11
ECU Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECU power source supplies power to the actuator and sensors, etc, when terminal GND and the cruise
control ECU case are grounded.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
Instrument Panel J/B
Ignition Switch
2
AM1
IG1
4
B–Y
1
1K
ECU–IG
J12
J/C
9
1J
C
B–R
9
C15
C
B–R
B
W
Instrument Panel J/B
FL BLOCK
1
B–G
ALT
1
F9
F4
J11
J/C
B–R
1
1B
AM1
2
1K
Instrument Panel J/B
7
8
A
A
1J
J7
1J
W–B
W–B
J/C A
J8
W–B
16
C15 GND
FL MAIN
Battery
IG
I08434
Author:
Date:
1144
DI–910
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Instrument panel junction block No.1:
ECU–IG
Fuse
PREPARATION:
Remove the ECU–IG fuse from instrument panel junction block
No.1.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
OK:
Continuity
I00157
NG
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to ECU–IG fuse.
OK
2
Check voltage between terminals B and GND of cruise control ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals B and GND of ECU connector.
OK:
10 – 14 V
ON
B
GND
(–)
(+)
AB0119
I00147
I00176
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
Author:
Date:
1145
DI–911
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check resistance between terminal GND of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal GND of ECU connector
and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
GND
I00140
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and repair harness and connector between cruise control ECU and battery
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1146
DI–912
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08Z–16
Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the cruise control main switch is turned OFF, the cruise control does not operate.
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–892.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal CMS of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal CMS of cruise control ECU
connector when main switch is held ON and OFF.
OK:
ON
CMS
(–)
(+)
Main switch
Voltage
OFF
10 – 14 V
ON
Below 0.5 V
AB0119
I00145
I00177
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
Author:
Date:
1147
DI–913
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check main switch continuity.
3
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove steering wheel center pad. (See page SR–11)
(b) Disconnect the control switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 of control switch
connector when main switch is held ON and OFF.
OK:
5
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
3–5
No continuity
Hold ON
3–5
Continuity
N15969
NG
Replace control switch.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and main switch
(See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1148
DI–914
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI090–17
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the cruise control main switch is turned ON, CRUISE MAIN indicator light lights up.
WIRING DIAGRAM
J4
J/C
D
D
R–L
CRUISE MAIN
Indicator Light
(in Combination Meter)
10
7
C10
C10
O
Cruise Control ECU
J2
J/C
5
IG2
D
4
D
O
O
PI
C15
R–L
Instrument Panel J/B
2
1D
GAUGE
1
1K
Ignition Switch
4
B–G
ALT
W
Instrument Panel J/B
FL BLOCK
1
F4
AM1 2
IG1
B–Y
1
F9
B–R
1
1B
AM1
2
1K
FL MAIN
Battery
I00290
Author:
Date:
1149
DI–915
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals PI and GND of cruise control ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
Tun ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PI and GND of cruise control ECU connector when main switch is ON and OFF.
OK:
ON
PI
(–)
AB0119
I00144
Switch position
Voltage
OFF
10 – 16 V
ON
Below 1.2 V
(+)
I00178
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
2
Check combination meter (See page BE–2).
NG
Replace combination meter.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1150
DI–916
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI091–11
Diagnosis Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a signal to the ECU that outputs DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
J2
J/C
D
4
D
C15
PI
O
O
10 D4
DLC2
J3
J/C
4 D4
B
5
B
C15
LG–R
LG–R
TC
B
LG–R
11 II3
DLC1
11
D1
LG–R*1
P–B*2
*1: TMC Made, TMMK Made (5S–FE)
*2: TMMK Made (1MZ–FE)
I00291
Author:
Date:
1151
DI–917
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2.
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
AB0119
I00169
TC
E1
I00179
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–879).
NG
2
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and DLC2, DLC2 and
body ground (See page IN–31).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–31).
Author:
Date:
1152
DI–918
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI092–07
Actuator Control Cable
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Actuator control cable inspection
OK:
(a) Check that the actuator and control cable throttle link are properly installed and that the cable and link
are connected correctly.
(b) Check that the actuator and bell crank operate smoothly.
(c) Check that the cable is not loose or too tight.
OK:
Freeplay: less than 10 mm
HINT:
If the control cable is very loose, the vehicle’s loss of speed going uphill will be large.
If the control cable is too tight, the idle RPM will become high.
Author:
Date:
1153
DI–919
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI1KE–04
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manual,
with the page number in the bottom portion. See
the pages for detailed explanations.
1
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–920
2
Check and Clear DTC (Precheck)
P. DI–921
Symptom
does not occur
3
Problem Symptom Confirmation
4
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–21
7
Problem Symptoms Table
P. DI–927
Symptom
occurs
5
Normal code
DTC Check
P. DI–921
Malfunction code
6
DTC Chart
P. DI–924
8
Circuit Inspection and part Inspection
P. DI–928 – DI–935
Identification of Problem
9
10
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step 2, 5 : Diagnostic steps permitting the use of the
TOYOTA hand–held tester or TOYOTA
break–out–box.
Author:
Date:
1154
DI–920
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI1KF–04
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ENGINE IMMOBLISER Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Date Problem First Occurred
/
Frequency Problem Occurs
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
times a day)
Immobiliser is not set.
(Engine starts with key codes other than the registered key code.)
Symptoms
Engine does not start.
Check Item
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Normal
Remains ON
Does not Light Up
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
DTC Check
Author:
Date:
1155
DI–921
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI1KG–04
TOYOTA hand–held tester
DLC3
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
ECM controls the function of immobiliser on this vehicle.
Data of the immobiliser or DTC can be read form DLC3 of
the vehicle. When a trouble occurs in immobiliser, MIL
does not light ON but DTC inspection is performed.
Therefore when there seems to be a trouble with immobiliser, use TOYOTA hand–held tester or SST to check and
troubleshoot it.
(b)
DLC3 INSPECTION
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141–2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of DLC3 complies with
SAEJ1962 and matches the ISO 9141–2 format.
S05335
N09214
Tester connection
condition
Specified condition
7 (Bus Line) – 5 (Signal ground)
During communication
4 (chassis Ground) – Body
Always
1 Ω or less
5 (Signal Ground) – Body
Always
1 Ω or less
16 (B+) – Body
Always
9 – 14 V
Pulse generation
HINT:
If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE”
when you have connected the cable of OBD ll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON
and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle
side or tool side.
(1) If communication is normal when the tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect DLC3 on the original vehicle.
(2) If communication is still impossible when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in the tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in the tool’s instruction manual.
Author:
Date:
1156
DI–922
DIAGNOSTICS
E1
DLC1
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
2.
(a)
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS
Check the DTC (Using TOYOTA hand–held tester)
(1) Prepare the OBD ll scan tool (complying with SAEJ
1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
(2) Connect the OBD ll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester to DLC3 under the instrument panel lower pad.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the OBD ll scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester switch ON.
(4) Use the OBD ll scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to check the DTCs and freeze frame data;
note them down. (For operating instructions, see
the OBD ll scan tool’s instruction book.)
(5) See page DI–924 to confirm the details of the DTCs.
(b)
Check the DTC (Using diagnosis check wire)
(1) Turn ignition switch ON.
(2) Using SST, connect between terminals 8 (TE1) and
3 (E1) of DLC1.
SST 09843–18040
(3) Read the diagnostic trouble code from malfunction
indicator lamp.
HINT:
TE1
F02201
As an example, the blinking patterns for codes; normal, 12 and
99 are as shown in the illustration.
Normal code
0.25 Sec.
If a diagnostic trouble code is not output, check the Tc terminal circuit .
ECM controls the immobiliser function on this vehicle,
DTC is out put with DTC of engine.
0.25 Sec.
BR3904
Author:
Date:
1157
DI–923
DIAGNOSTICS
0.5 Sec. 0.5 Sec.
1.5 Sec. 2.5 Sec.
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Malfunction Code (Example Code 12, 99)
4.5 Sec.
One Cycle
I02680
(4)
(5)
When DTC ”99” is output, there is a trouble with
immobiliser. Start troubleshooting referring to
PROBLEM SYMPTOM TABLE.
After completing the check, disconnect terminals 13
(TC) and 4 (CG) and turn OFF the display.
HINT:
In the event of 2 or more malfunction codes. indication will begin
from the smaller numbered code and continue in order to the
larger.
(c) Clear the DTC
The following procedures will erase the DTCs and freeze frame
data.
(1) Operating the OBD ll scam tool (complying with
SAEJ1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase
the codes. (See the OBD ll scan tool’s instruction
book for operating instructions.)
(2) Disconnecting the battery terminals or EFI fuse.
Author:
Date:
1158
DI–924
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI1KH–03
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DTC No.
(See page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Unmatched key code
Key
Unregistered key inserted before
B2796
(DI–929)
No communication in immobiliser system
Key
Transponder key coil
Amplifier
Wirehaness
ECM
B2797
(DI–932)
Communication malfunction No.1
Communication contests
Unregistered key inserted before
Communication malfunction No.2
Key
Transponder key coil
Amplifier
Wirehaness
ECM
B2795
(DI–928)
B2798
(DI–935)
HINT:
To reduce the unnecessary exchange of ECM, check that a trouble occurs with the original ECM at the time
of exchanging ECM and the trouble will disappear with a new ECM.
Author:
Date:
1159
DI–925
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI1KI–04
PARTS LOCATION
Engine Room J/B No.2
EFI Fuse
Transponder Key Amplifier
Transponder Key Coil
ECM
Instrument Panel J/B
IGN Fuse
I02682
Author:
Date:
1160
DI–926
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI1KJ–04
TERMINALS OF ECM
E7
E8
E9
E10
E11
D01054
5S–FE engine:
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
CODE – E1
(E10–8 ↔ E9–24)
G–W ↔ BR
Ignition Switch ON
10 – 14
TXCK – E1
(E10–9 ↔ E9–24)
L–Y ↔ BR
Ignition Switch ON
10 – 14
RXCK – E1
(E10–3 ↔ E9–24)
R–L ↔ BR
Ignition Switch ON
10 – 14
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
CODE – E1
(E9–4 ↔ E10–17)
G–W ↔ BR
Ignition Switch ON
10 – 14
TXCK – E1
(E9–10 ↔ E10–17)
L–Y ↔ BR
Ignition Switch ON
10 – 14
RXCK – E1
(E9–5 ↔ E10–17)
R–L ↔ BR
Ignition Switch ON
10 – 14
1MZ–FE engine:
Author:
Date:
1161
DI–927
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI1KK–03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspect Area
Immobiliser is not set.
(Engine starts with key codes other than the registered key code.)
2. ECM
Engine does not start.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
See page
IN–31
Key
Wire harness
Transponder key coil
Amplifier
ECM
*1
IN–31
BE–128
IN–31
*2
IN–31
IN–31
Security indicator is always ON.
1. Security indicator
2. Wire harness
3. ECM
Security indicator is always ON.
(Although code has been registered in the automatic registration
mode, indicator is not OFF.)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Wire harness
Transponder key coil
Amplifier
ECM
IN–31
BE–128
Security indicator is OFF
(When DTC of immobiliser is output)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Wire harness
Transponder key coil
Amplifier
ECM
IN–31
BE–128
IN–31
IN–31
Security indicator is OFF.
(When DTC of immobiliser is not output)
1. Wire harness
2. ECM
IN–31
IN–31
Security indicator is abnormally brinking.
1. Wire harness
2. ECM
IN–31
IN–31
*1 : Check that the key which did not start the engine has been registered and that it is possible to start with
other already registered key codes.
*2 : Finish the automatic registration mode because the mode might still remain.
Author:
Date:
1162
DI–928
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI1KN–02
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
B2795/99 Unmatched Key Code
This DTC is output when an unregistered key is inserted. When this DTC is output, delete DTC and insert
the key that a customer keeps to check that B2795 is output.
When a key that outputs B2795 is found, register this key. When B2795 is not output, there is a possibility
that the unregistered key has been inserted before. (ECM is normal.)
Inquire of a customer about the condition of using the system to find the cause of the trouble.
(Example: Another key has been inserted, etc.)
Author:
Date:
1163
DI–929
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI4FF–01
DTC
B2796/99 No Communication in Immobiliser system
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
B2796/99
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Key
Transponder Key Coil
Transponder Key Amplifier
Wireharness
ECM
No communication
WIRING DIAGRAM
5S–FE engine:
ECM
Transponder Key Amplifier
2
G–W
3
R–L
4
L–Y
1
II4
4
II4
2
II4
G–W
8
E10 CODE
3
R–L
E10 RXCK
9
L–Y
E10 TXCT
I08435
Author:
Date:
1164
DI–930
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
1MZ–FE engine:
ECM
Transponder Key Amplifier
2
G–W
3
R–L
4
L–Y
4
E9
CODE
5
E9
RXCK
10
E9
TXCT
I03114
Author:
Date:
1165
DI–931
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check transponder key coil (See page BE–128).
NG
Replace transponder key coil.
OK
2
Check harness and connector between transponder key amplifier and ECM.
NG
Repair or replace harness and connector.
OK
3
Does it operate normally after replacement of transponder key amplifier?
Yes
Replace transponder key amplifier.
No
Replace ECM.
Author:
Date:
1166
DI–932
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI4FG–01
DTC
B2797/99 Communication Malfunction No.1
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This code is detected when although the communication has been performed normally, an error occurs.
(Example. Some noise is inclueded in communication line.)
DTC No.
B2797/99
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Wire Harness
Transponder Key Amplifier
ECM
Communication error
WIRING DIAGRAM
5S–FE engine:
ECM
Transponder Key Amplifier
2
G–W
3
R–L
4
L–Y
1
II4
4
II4
2
II4
G–W
8
E10 CODE
3
R–L
E10 RXCK
9
L–Y
E10 TXCT
I08435
Author:
Date:
1167
DI–933
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
1MZ–FE engine:
ECM
Transponder Key Amplifier
2
G–W
3
R–L
4
L–Y
4
E9
CODE
5
E9
RXCK
10
E9
TXCT
I03114
Author:
Date:
1168
DI–934
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Noise check
PREPARATION:
Insert already registered master key in the key cylinder.
CHECK:
Using an oscilloscope or TOYOTA hand–held tester, check that
noise is included in the CODE terminal of ECM.
OK:
No noise is detected.
Noise
I02681
NG
Try to find the cause of the noise and remove it.
OK
2
Does it operate normally after replacement of transponder key amplifier?
Yes
Replace transponder key amplifier.
No
Replace ECM.
Author:
Date:
1169
DI–935
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
DI4FH–01
DTC
B2798/99 Communication malfunction No.2
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
B2798/99
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Key
Transponder Key Coil
Transponder Key Amplifier
Wireharness
ECM
Communication error
WIRING DIAGRAM
5S–FE engine:
ECM
Transponder Key Amplifier
2
G–W
3
R–L
4
L–Y
1
II4
4
II4
2
II4
G–W
8
E10 CODE
3
R–L
E10 RXCK
9
L–Y
E10 TXCT
I08435
Author:
Date:
1170
DI–936
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
1MZ–FE engine:
ECM
Transponder Key Amplifier
2
G–W
3
R–L
4
L–Y
4
E9
CODE
5
E9
RXCK
10
E9
TXCT
I03114
Author:
Date:
1171
DI–937
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check transponder key coil (See page BE–128).
NG
Replace transponder key coil
OK
2
Check harness and connector between transponder key amplifier and ECM.
NG
Repair or replace harness and connector
OK
3
Does it operate normally after replacement of transponder key amplifier?
Yes
Replace transponder key amplifier.
No
Replace ECM.
Author:
Date:
1172
DI–1
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
ENGINE
DI00F–10
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following page.
Titles inside
are titles of pages in
this manual with the page number indicated
in the bottom portion. See the indicated
pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
2
Customer Problem Analysis P. DI–2
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3 P. DI–3
If display indicates a communication fault in tool, inspect DLC3 P. DI–3
3
Check DTC and Freezed Frame Data (Precheck)
Record or Print DTC and Freezed Frame Data P. DI–3
4
Clear DTC and Freezed Frame Data P. DI–3
5
Visual Inspection
6
Setting Check Mode Diagnosis P. DI–3
7
Problem Symptom Confirmation
If engine does not start perform steps 10 and 12 first
Malfunction
occurs.
9
10
DTC Check P. DI–3
Normal
Basic Inspection P. DI–3
12
14
8
Malfunction code.
11
DTC Chart P. DI–3
Problem Symptoms Table P. DI–21
Parts Inspection
15
Malfunction does not occur.
Symptom Simulation P. IN–19
13
Circuit Inspection P. DI–22
Check for Intermittent Problems P. DI–3
Identification of Problem
16
Adjustment, Repair
17
Confirmation Test
End
Author:
Date:
71
DI–2
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00G–07
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
Model and Model
Year
Driver’s Name
Frame No.
Data Vehicle
Brought in
Engine Model
License No.
Odometer Reading
Problem Symptoms
Customer’s Name
Engine does
not Start
Engine does not crank
Difficult to
Start
Engine cranks slowly
Other
Poor Idling
Incorrect first idle
Idling rpm is abnormal
Rough idling
Other
Poor
Driveability
Hesitation
Knocking
Engine Stall
Soon after starting
After accelerator pedal depressed
After accelerator pedal released
During A/C operation
Shifting from N to D
Other
km
miles
No initial combustion
Back fire
Other
No complete combustion
High (
rpm)
Low (
Muffler explosion (after–fire)
Surging
Others
Datas Problem
Occurred
Constant
Other
Condition When
Problem Occurs
Problem Frequency
Sometimes (
times per
day/month)
Weather
Fine
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
Outdoor
Temperature
Hot
Warm
Cool
Cold (approx.
Place
Highway
Rough road
Engine Temperature
Engine Operation
Cold
Suburbs
Other
Warming up
Inner city
After warming up
Just after starting (
Starting
Driving
Constant speed
A/C switch ON/OFF
Other
Condition of MIL
Normal Mode
(Precheck)
Once only
Various/Other
°F/
°C)
Uphill
Downhill
Any temperature
min.)
Idling
Acceleration
Other
Racing
Deceleration
Remains on
Sometimes lights up
Does not light up
Normal
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freezed frame data (
)
Malfunction code(s) (code
Freezed frame data (
)
)
DTC Inspection
Check Mode
Normal
)
rpm)
DI–3
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI64S–01
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure
is that you connect to the vehicle the OBD II scan
tool complying with SAE J1978 or TOYOTA hand–
held tester, and read off various data output from
the vehicle’s ECM.
S05347
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester
DLC3
S05331
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s on–
board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the emission control
system/components or in the power train control
components which affect vehicle emissions, or a
malfunction in the computer. In addition to the MIL
lighting up when a malfunction is detected, the applicable Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) prescribed
by SAE J2012 are recorded in the ECM memory.
(See page DI–14)
If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3 consecutive trips, the
MIL goes off automarially but the DTCs remain recorded in the
ECM memory.
To check the DTCs, connect the OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) on the vehicle. The OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester also enables you
to erase the DTCs and check freezed frame data
and various forms of engine data (For operating
instructions, see the OBD II scan tool’s instruction
book.)
DTCs include SAE controlled codes and manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled codes must
be set as prescribed by the SAE, while manufacturer controlled codes can be set freely by the
manufacturer within the prescribed limits. (See DTC
chart on page DI–14)
DI–4
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode
during normal vehicle use. It also has a check mode
for technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms
and troubleshoot. Most DTCs use 2 trip detection
logic* to prevent erroneous detection, and ensure
thorough malfunction detection. By switching the
ECM to check mode when troubleshooting, the
technician can cause the MIL to light up for a malfunction that is only detected once or momentarily.
(TOYOTA hand–held tester only)
(See page DI–3)
*2 trip detection logic: When a malfunction is first
detected, the malfunction is temporarily stored in
the ECM memory. (1st trip)
If the same malfunction is detected again during the second
drive test, this second detection causes the MIL to light up. (2nd
trip) (However, the ignition switch must be turned OFF between
the 1st trip and 2nd trip.)
Freeze frame data:
Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when a misfire (DTCs P0300 – P0304) or fuel trim
malfunction (DTCs P0171 and P0172) or other malfunction (first malfunction only), is detected. Because freeze frame data records the engine conditions (fuel system, calculated load, engine coolant
temperature, fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle
speed, etc.) when the malfunction is detected.
When troubleshooting, it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was
lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Priorities for troubleshooting.
If troubleshooting priorities for multiple DTCs are given in the
applicable DTC chart, these should be followed.
If no instructions are given, troubleshoot DTCs according to the
following priorities.
(1) DTCs other than fuel trim malfunction (DTCs P0171
and P0172), EGR (DTCs P0401 and P0402), and
misfire (DTCs P0300 – P0304).
(2) Fuel trim malfunction (DTCs P0171 and P0172),
and EGR (DTCs P0401 and P0402).
(3) Misfire (DTCs P0300 – P0304).
DI–5
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
–
ENGINE
Check the DLC3.
The vehicle’s ECM uses ISO 9141–2 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE
J1962 and matches the ISO 9141–2 format.
9 10 11 12 1314 15 16
DLC3
A04550
Terminal No.
Connection/Voltage or Resistance
Condition
7
Bus Line/Pulse generation
During transmission
4
Chassis Ground ↔ Body Ground/1 Ω or less
Always
5
Signal Ground ↔ Body Ground/1 Ω or less
Always
16
Battery Positive ↔ Body Ground/9 – 14 V
Always
HINT:
If your display shows UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE
when you have connected the cable of the OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch
ON and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle side or tool side.
If communication is normal when the tool is connected to
another vehicle, inspect DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in the
tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in the
tool’s instruction manual.
2.
(a)
S05347
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (Normal Mode)
Check the MIL.
(1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned
ON and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter
(See Pub. No. RM654U, page BE–2).
(2) When the engine started, the MIL should go off. If
the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system has detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
(b) Check the DTC.
NOTICE:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only: When the diagnosis system is switched from normal mode to check mode, it
erases all DTCs and freezed frame data recorded in normal
mode. So before switching modes, always check the DTCs
and freezed frame data, and note them down.
(1) Prepare the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
DI–6
DIAGNOSTICS
(2)
(3)
(4)
–
ENGINE
Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester to DLC3 under the instrument panel lower pad.
Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester switch ON.
Use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester to check the DTCs and freezed frame data
and note them down. (For operating instructions,
see the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book.)
See page DI–3 to confirm the details of the DTCs.
(5)
NOTICE:
When simulating symptoms with an OBD II scan tool
(excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) to check the
DTCs, use normal mode. For code on the DTC chart
subject to ”2 trip detection logic”, perform the following either action.
Turn the ignition switch OFF after the symptom is
simulated the first time. Then repeat the simulation
process again. When the problem has been simulated
twice, the MIL lights up and the DTCs are recorded in
the ECM.
Check the 1st trip DTC using Mode 7 (Continuous Test
Results) for SAE J1979.
(c) Clear the DTC.
The DTCs and freezed frame data will be erased by either
action.
(1) Operating the OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or TOYOTA hand–held tester to erase the
codes. (See the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book
for operating instructions.)
(2) Disconnecting the battery terminals or EFI fuse.
NOTICE:
If the TOYOTA hand–held tester switches the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice–versa, or if the ignition
switch is turned from ON to ACC or OFF during check
mode, the DTCs and freezed frame data will be erased.
3.
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (Check Mode)
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester only:
Compared to the normal mode, the check mode has an increased sensitivity to detect malfunctions.
Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are detected in
the normal mode can also be detected in the check mode.
(a) Check the DTC.
(1) Initial conditions
Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
Throttle valve fully closed
Transmission in P or N position
Air conditioning switched OFF
(2) Turn ignition switch OFF.
DI–7
DIAGNOSTICS
–
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Flashing
ON
OFF
0.13 Second
FI3605
ENGINE
Prepare the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC3 under the instrument panel lower pad.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA
hand–held tester ON.
Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the normal mode to the check mode. (Check that the MIL
flashes.)
NOTICE:
If the TOYOTA hand–held tester switches the ECM from
normal mode to check mode or vice–versa, or if the ignition switch is turned from ON to ACC or LOCK during check
mode, the DTCs and freezed frame data will be erased.
(7) Start the engine. (The MIL goes out after the engine
start.)
(8) Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by the customer.
NOTICE:
Leave the ignition switch ON until you have checked the
DTC, etc.
(9) After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
TOYOTA hand–held tester diagnosis selector to
check the DTCs and freezed frame data, etc.
HINT:
Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF. Turning the ignition
switch OFF switches the diagnosis system from check mode to
normal mode. So all DTCs, etc. are erased.
(10) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
4.
FAIL–SAFE CHART
If any of the following codes is recorded, the ECM enters fail–safe mode.
DTC No.
Fail–Safe Operation
Fail–Safe Deactivation Conditions
P0105
Ignition timing fixed at 5° BTDC
Returned to normal condition
P0110
Intake air temperature is fixed at 20°C (68°F)
Returned to normal condition
P0115
Engine coolant temperature is fixed at 80°(176°F)
Returned to normal condition
P0120
VTA is fixed at 0°
The following condition must be repeated at least 2 times consecutively VTA 0.1 V and 0.95 V
P0141
The heater circuit in witch an abnormality is detected is
turned off
Ignition switch OFF
P1135
The heater circuit in which an abnormality is detected is
turned off
Ignition switch OFF
P1300
P1310
Fuel cut
IGF signal is detected for 2 consecutive ignitions
DI–8
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
5.
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
TOYOTA hand–held tester only:
By putting the vehicle’s ECM in the check mode, 1 trip detection logic is possible instead of 2 trip detection
logic and sensitivity to detect open circuits is increased. This makes it easier to detect intermittent problems.
(1) Clear the DTC (See step 2).
(2) Set the check mode (See step 3).
(3) Perform a simulation test (See page IN–19).
(4) Check the connector and terminal (See page IN–29).
(5) Handle the connector (See page IN–29).
6.
BASIC INSPECTION
When the malfunction code is not confirmed in the DTC check, troubleshooting should be performed in order
for all possible circuits to be considered as the causes of the problems. In many cases, by carrying out the
basic engine check shown in the following flow chart, the location causing the problem can be found quickly
and efficiently. Therefore, use of this check is essential in engine troubleshooting.
1
Is battery positive voltage 11 V or more when engine is stopped?
NO
Charge or replace battery.
YES
2
Is engine cranked?
NO
Proceed to Pub. No. RM654U, page ST–2 and
continue to troubleshoot.
NO
Go to step 7.
YES
3
YES
Does engine start?
DI–9
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE
Check air filter.
PREPARATION:
Remove the air filter.
CHECK:
Visually check that the air filter is not dirty or excessive oily.
HINT:
If necessary, clean the air filter with compressed air. First blow
from inside thoroughly, then blow from outside of the air filter.
Outside
Inside
P00495
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check idle speed.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Switch off all the accessories.
(c) Switch off the A/C.
(d) Shift the transmission into the N position.
(e) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
CHECK:
Use the CURRENT DATA to check the idle speed.
OK:
Idle speed: 650 – 750 rpm
NG
OK
Proceed to problem symptoms table on page
DI–21.
DI–10
DIAGNOSTICS
6
TE1
–
Check ignition timing.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Shift the transmission into the N position.
(c) Keep the engine speed at idle.
(d) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(e) Using a timing light, connect the tester to the No.1 high–
tension cord.
CHECK:
Check the ignition timing.
OK:
Ignition timing: 10° BTDC at idle
E1
SST
DLC1
NG
A07370
S05309
ENGINE
A07664
Proceed to page IG–1 and continue to troubleshoot.
OK
Proceed to problem symptoms table on page
DI–21.
7
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank.
A09429
PREPARATION:
(a) Be sure that enough fuel is in the tank.
(b) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and push TOYOTA hand–held
tester main switch ON.
(d) Use the ACTIVE TEST mode to operate the fuel shutoff
valve for the fuel tank.
(e) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
(f)
If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, Connect between terminal FC of the ECM connector and body
ground.
CHECK:
Check the operating sound of the fuel shutoff valve for the fuel
tank when it is operated.
DI–11
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
OK:
There is operating sound from the shutoff valve.
NG
Proceed to page SF–34 and continue to troubleshoot.
OK
8
Check for spark.
A00359
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the high–tension cord from the spark plug.
(b) Remove the spark plug.
(c) Install the spark plug to the high–tension cord.
(d) Disconnect the injector connector.
(e) Ground the spark plug.
CHECK:
Check if spark occurs while the engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
To prevent excess fuel from being injected from the injectors during this test, don’t crank the engine for more than
5 – 10 seconds at a time.
NG
Proceed to page IG–1 and continue to troubleshoot.
OK
Proceed to problem symptoms table on page
DI–21.
7.
ENGINE OPERATING CONDITION
NOTICE:
The values given below for ”Normal Condition” are representative values, so a vehicle may still be
normal even if its value varies from those listed here. So do not decide whether a part is faulty or
not solely according to the ”Normal Condition” here.
(a) CARB mandated signals.
TOYOTA hand–held tester display
Measurement Item
Normal Condition*1
FUEL SYS #1
Fuel System Bank 1
OPEN: Air–fuel ratio feedback stopped
CLOSED: Air–fuel ratio feedback operating
Idling after warming up: CLOSED
CALC LOAD
Calculator Load: Current intake air volume as a
proportion of max. intake air volume
Idling: 19.7 – 50.4 %
Racing without load (2,500rpm): 16.8 – 47.4 %
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor Value
After warming up: 80 – 95°C (176 – 203°F)
COOLANT TEMP
DI–12
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
SHORT FT #1
Short–term Fuel Trim Bank 1
0 ± 20 %
LONG FT #1
Long–term Fuel Trim Bank 1
0 ± 20 %
ENGINE SPD
Engine Speed
Idling: 650 – 750 rpm
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle Speed
Vehicle Stopped: 0 km/h (0 mph)
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition Advance: Ignition Timing of Cylinder No.1
Idling: BTDC 0 – 10°
Intake Air Temp. Sensor Value
Equivalent to Ambient Temp.
Absolute Pressure inside Intake Manifold
Idling: 20 – 51 kPa
Racing without load (2,500 rpm): 17 – 48 kPa
THROTTLE POS
Voltage Output of Throttle Position Sensor Calculated as a percentage: 0 V → 0 %, 5 V → 100 %
Throttle Fully Closed: 6 – 16 %
Throttle Fully Open: 64 – 98 %
O2S B1 S1
Voltage Output of Heated Oxygen Sensor Bank 1
Sensor 1
Idling: 0.1 – 0.9 V (0.56 – 0.76 V*2)
O2FT B1 S1
Heated Oxygen Sensor Fuel Trim Bank 1 Sensor
1 (Same as SHORT FT #1)
0 ± 20 %
A/FS B1 S1
Voltage Output of A/F Sensor
Idling: 2.8 – 3.8 V
A/FFT B1 S1
A/F Sensor Fuel Trim (Same as SHORT FT #1)
0 ± 20 %
Voltage Output of Heated Oxygen Sensor Bank 1
Sensor 2
Driving at 50 km/h (31 mph): 0.05 – 0.95 V
INTAKE AIR
MAP
O2S B1 S2
*1: If no conditions are specifically stated for ”ldling”, it means the shift lever is at N or P position, the A/C
switch is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
*2: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
(b) TOYOTA Enhanced Signals.
TOYOTA hand–held tester display
Measurement Item
Normal Condition*
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire range
Misfire 0: 0 rpm
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range
Misfire 0: 0 g/r
Fuel injection time for cylinder No.1
Idling: 2.9 – 5.1 ms
Intake Air Control Valve Duty Ratio
Opening ratio rotary solenoid type IAC valve
Idling: 25 – 62 %
Starter Signal
Cranking: ON
CTP SIG
Closed Throttle Position Signal
Throttle fully closed: ON
A/C SIG
A/C Switch Signal
A/C ON: ON
PNP SIG
Park/Neutral Position Switch Signal
P or N position: ON
Electrical Load Signal
Defogger S/W ON: ON
Stop Light Switch Signal
Stop light switch ON: ON
Power Steering Oil Pressure Switch Signal
Turn steering wheel: ON
FC IDL
Fuel Cut Idle: Fuel cut when throttle valve fully
closed, during deceleration
Fuel cut operating: ON
FC TAU
Fuel Cut TAU: Fuel cut during very light load
Fuel cut operating: ON
CYL#1, CYL#2, CYL#3, CYL#4
Abnormal revolution variation for each cylinder
0%
IGNITION
Total number of ignition for every 1,000 revolutions
0 – 2,000
EGR system operating condition
Idling: OFF
FUEL PUMP
Fuel Pump Signal
Idling: ON
A/C CUT SIG
A/C Cut Signal
A/C S/W OFF: ON
A/C MAG CLUTCH
A/C Switch Signal
A/C ON: ON
EVAP (PURGE) VSV
EVAP VSV Signal
VSV operating: Avove 30 %
INJECTOR
IAC DUTY RATIO
STARTER SIG
ELECTCL LOAD SIG
STOP LIGHT SW
PS OIL PRESS SW
EGR SYSTEM
DI–13
DIAGNOSTICS
VAPOR PRESS VSV
TOTAL FT B1
–
ENGINE
Vapor Pressure VSV Signal
VSV operating: ON
Total Fuel Trim Bank 1: Average value for fuel
trim system of bank 1
Idling: 0.8 – 1.2 V
*: If no conditions are specifically stated for ”ldling”, it means the shift lever is at N or P position, the A/C switch
is OFF and all accessory switches are OFF.
DI–14
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00I–11
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Parameters listed in the chart may not be exactly the same as your reading due to the type of instrument
or other factors.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check in check mode, check the circuit for that code listed
in the table below. For details of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ’’See page ’’ for the respective ’’DTC No.’’ in the DTC chart.
1.
SAE CONTROLLED
DTC No.
(See page)
Detection Item
P0105
(DI–22)
Manifold Absolute Pressure/
Barometric Pressure Circuit Malfunction
P0106
(DI–25)
MIL*
Memory
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
Manifold Absolute Pressure Circuit Range/Performance Problem
Vacuum line
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
P0110
(DI–26)
Intake Air Temp. Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM
P0115
(DI–30)
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
P0116
(DI–34)
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit
Range/Performance Problem
Cooling system
Engine coolant temp. sensor
P0120
(DI–35)
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0121
(DI–39)
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/
Switch ”A” Circuit Range/Performance Problem
Throttle position sensor
P0125
(DI–40)
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for
Closed Loop Fuel Control
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Air induction system
EGR system
Fuel pressure
Injector
Gas leakage on exhaust system
ECM
P0136
(DI–45)
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
Heated oxygen sensor
P0141
(DI–47)
Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit
Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
ECM
System too Lean (Fuel Trim)
Air induction system
Injector blockage
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
ECM
P0171
(DI–49)
Trouble Area
DI–15
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
P0172
(DI–49)
System too Rich (Fuel Trim)
Injector leak, blockage
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Ignition system
Fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
ECM
P0180
(DI–54)
Fuel Temperature Sensor ”A”
Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in fuel temperature sensor circuit for delivery
pipe
Fuel temperature sensor for delivery pipe
ECM
P0190
(DI–56)
Fuel Rail Pressure Sensor Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in fuel pressure sensor circuit for delivery pipe
Fuel pressure sensor for delivery pipe
ECM
P0335
(DI–59)
Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A”
Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft timing pulley
ECM
P0340
(DI–61)
Camshaft Position Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
ECM
P0400
(DI–63)
Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow
Malfunction
Vacuum or EGR hose is connected to wrong post
Open or short in VSV circuit for EGR
VSV for EGR
EGR system
EGR vacuum modulator
EGR valve
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
P0500
(DI–69)
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
Combination meter
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
ECM
Idle Control System Malfunction
Open or short in IAC valve circuit
IAC valve is stuck or closed
Open or short in A/C switch circuit
Air induction system
ECM
MIL*
Memory
P0505
(DI–72)
*: MIL lights up
2.
MANUFACTURER CONTROLLED
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P1130
(DI–79)
A/F Sensor Circuit Range/Performance Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
Air induction system
EGR system
Fuel pressure
Injector
ECM
P1135
(DI–84)
A/F Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
ECM
DI–16
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
P1190
(DI–86)
Fuel Pressure Regulator Malfunction
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel tank
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel pressure regulator
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator
Fuel pressure regulator
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel delivery pipe
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel delivery pipe
ECM
P1240
(DI–95)
Fuel Fuel Shutoff Valve Circuit
for Delivery Pipe Malfunction
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel delivery pipe
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel delivery pipe
ECM
–
P1245
(DI–98)
Fuel Fuel Shutoff Valve Circuit
for Pressure Regulator Malfunction
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel pressure regulator
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator
ECM
–
Igniter Circuit Malfunction (No.1)
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF or IGT1 circuit from No.1 ignition coil with
igniter to ECM
No.1 ignition coil with igniter
ECM
P1310
(DI–102)
Igniter Circuit Malfunction (No.2)
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF or IGT2 circuit from No.2 ignition coil with
igniter to ECM
No.2 ignition coil with igniter
ECM
P1335
(DI–107)
Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction (During engine
running)
Open short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft timing pulley
ECM
–
P1520
(DI–108)
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
ECM BATT Malfunction
Open in back up power source circuit
ECM
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Malfunction
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
P1300
(DI–102)
P1600
(DI–110)
P1780
(DI–112)
*: ... MIL lights up. – ... MIL does not light up.
DI–17
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI1JS–04
PARTS LOCATION
Manifold Absolute
Pressure Sensor
Combination Meter
for Speedometer
Throttle Position Sensor
ECM
Injector
DLC3
Fuel Temperature
Sensor for
Delivery Pipe
Fuel Pressure
Sensor for
Delivery Pipe
Heated Oxygen
Sensor (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
Fuel Temperature
Sensor for Fuel
Tank
DLC1
Camshaft Position
Sensor
VSV for EGR
Crankshaft Position
Sensor
Fuel Shutoff Valve
for Fuel Tank
A/F Sensor
Bank 1
Sensor 1)
Engine Coolant
Temperature
Sensor
Intake Air Temperature
Sensor
P ar k/ N eut ral
Position Switch
Fuel Pressure Sensor
for Fuel Pipe
Fuel Pressure Regulator
Fuel Shutoff Valve for
Pressure Regulator
Idle Air Control
Valve
Ignition Coil (No.1, No.2)
A09176
DI–18
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI64T–01
TERMINALS OF ECM
ECM Terminals
E5
E6
E7
E4
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 1110 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
262524 2322 2120191817 16 1514 16 151413 12 1110 9 12 11 10 9 8 7 22 21 201918 171615 1413 12
A02958
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
BATT (E4–1) – E1 (E6–16)
B–Y ↔ BR
Always
9 – 14
+B (E4–12) – E1 (E6–16)
B–Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 – 14
VC (E5–1) – E2 (E5–9)
Y ↔ BR
IG switch ON
4.5 – 5.5
IG switch ON
3.3 – 3.9
PIM (E5–2)
(E5 2) – E2 (E5–9)
(E5 9)
B Y ↔ BR
B–Y
Apply vacuum 26.7 kPa (200 mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg)
2.5 – 3.1
THA (E5–3) – E2 (E5–9)
Y–B ↔ BR
Idling, Intake air temp. 20°C (68° F)
0.5 – 3.4
THW (E5–4) – E2 (E5–9)
G–B ↔ BR
Idling, Engine coolant temp. 80°C (176°F)
0.2 – 1.0
LG ↔ BR
IG switch ON, Throttle valve fully closed
0.3 – 1.0
VTA (E5
(E5–11)
11) – E2 (E5
(E5–9)
9)
IG switch ON, Throttle valve fully open
3.2 – 4.9
AF+ (E5–6) – E1 (E6–16)
L ↔ BR
Always (IG switch ON)
3.3 fixed*
AF– (E5–14) – E1 (E6–16)
B–W ↔ BR
Always (IG switch ON)
3.0 fixed*
Idling
Below 3.0
HT2 (E6–21)
(E6 21) – E1 (E6–16)
(E6 16)
P B ↔ BR
P–B
THCNG2 (E7–6) – E2 (E5–9)
P–B ↔ BR
PCNG2 (E7–5) – E2 (E5–9)
G–B ↔ BR
Idling ON, Fuel temperature 20°C (68° F)
STA (E4–11)
(E4 11) – E1 (E6
(E6–16)
16)
GR ↔ BR
C ki
Cranking
IGT1 (E6–20) – E1 (E6–16)
B ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–102)
IGT2 (E6–19) – E1 (E6–16)
Y–R ↔ BR
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–102)
IGF (E6–3) – E1 (E6–16)
W–R ↔ BR
G (E6–5) – NE– (E6–17)
NE (E6–4) – NE– (E6–17)
IG switch ON
IG switch ON, Fuel temperature
9 – 14
–20°C (4° F)
20°C (68° F)
80°C (176° F)
IG switch ON, Disconnect ignition coil connector
EGR (E6–23) – E01(E6–13)
0.66 – 0.78
2.5 – 2.75
4.42 – 4.52
3.1 – 3.6
6 0 or more
6.0
4.5 – 5.5
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–102)
B–W ↔ L
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–59)
B–R ↔ L
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–59)
P–B ↔ BR
IG switch ON
0–3
OX2 (E5–5) – E1 (E6–16)
B ↔ BR
Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm for 2 min. after warming up
RSD (E6–10) – E1 (E6–16)
W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
FC (E4–14) – E01 (E6–13)
G–R ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 – 14
Pulse generation
DI–19
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
VCNG2 (E7–9) – E01 (E6–13)
Y–G ↔ BR
Idling ON,
9 – 14
VCNG3 (E7–4) – E01 (E6–13)
P ↔ BR
Idling ON,
9 – 14
IG switch ON, Other shift position in P or N
9 – 14
NSW (E4–6)
(E4 6) – E1 (E6–16)
(E6 16)
B W ↔ BR
B–W
IG switch ON, Shift position in P or N
0 – 3.0
Pulse generation
(See page DI–69)
SPD (E4–9) – E1 (E6–16)
V–W ↔ BR
IG switch ON, Rotate driving wheel slowly
TE1 (E5–15) – E1 (E6–16)
L–W ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 – 14
G R ↔ BR
G–R
Idling
9 – 14
W (E4–5)
(E4 5) – E1 (E6
(E6–16)
16)
HTAF (E4–2)
(E4 2) – E04 (E4–13)
(E4 13)
IG switch ON
Below 3.0
Idling
Below 3.0
G ↔ BR
IG switch ON
LOCK IN (E6–18) – E1 (E6–16)
W–L ↔ BR
A/C compressor is operating
LOCK (E4–15) – E1 (E6–16)
R–W ↔ BR
A/C indicator light lights up
A/C SW (E4
(E4–10)
10) – E1 (E6
(E6–16)
16)
R B ↔ BR
R–B
PRS (E7–10) – E1 (E6–16)
G ↔ BR
MGC (E4–21)
(E4 21) – E01 (E6–13)
(E6 13)
L Y ↔ BR
L–Y
STP (E4–4)
(E4 4) – E1 (E6–16)
(E6 16)
G W ↔ BR
G–W
SIL (E4–16) – E1 (E6–16)
W ↔ BR
TACH (E4–8) – E1 (E6–16)
B–O ↔ BR
LG–B ↔ BR
#10 (E6–12) – E01 (E6–13)
B – W ↔ BR
A/C switch OFF
Below 1.0
A/C pressure is normally
Below 1.0
A/C magnetic clutch ON
Below 1.0
A/C magnetic clutch OFF
9 – 14
IG switch ON, Brake pedal depressed
R ↔ BR
Below 1.5
During transmission
Pulse generation
Idling
Pulse generation
Idling
Idling
IG switch ON
#30 (E6–25) – E01 (E6–13)
7.5 – 14
IG switch ON, Brake pedal released
IG switch ON
B –R ↔ BR
Below 4.0
9 – 14
IG switch ON
#20 (E6–11) – E01 (E6–13)
Pulse generation
(See page DI–119)
A/C switch ON
IG switch ON at fuel temperature
THCNG1 (E7–1) – E2 (E5–9)
9 – 14
Idling
IG switch ON
–30°C (22° F)
25°C (77° F)
40°C (104° F)
100°C (212° F)
0.56 – 0.45
3.39 – 3.29
4.0 – 3.9
4.85 – 4.82
9 ∼ 14
Pulse generation
(See page DI–127)
9 ∼ 14
Pulse generation
(See page DI–127)
9 ∼ 14
Pulse generation
(See page DI–127)
9 ∼ 14
#40 (E6–24) – E01 (E6–13)
B – W ↔ BR
#10 (E6–2)
#10+
(E6 2) – E01 (E6–13)
(E6 13)
L ↔ BR
IG switch
it h ON
9 ∼ 14
#20 (E6–1)
#20+
(E6 1) – E01 (E6–13)
(E6 13)
B ↔ BR
IG switch
it h ON
9 ∼ 14
#30 (E6–15)
#30+
(E6 15) – E01 (E6–13)
(E6 13)
G ↔ BR
IG switch
it h ON
9 ∼ 14
#40+ (E6–14) – E01 (E6–13)
L ↔ BR
IG switch ON
9 ∼ 14
Idling
Pulse generation
(See page DI–127)
DI–20
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
IG switch ON, Needle position of fuel level gauge
PCNG1 (E7–7) – E2 (E5–9)
G–R ↔ BR
4/4
3/4
2/4
1/4
*: The ECM terminal voltage is fixed regardless of the output voltage from the sensor.
3.3
2.7
2.0
1.3
DI–21
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00L–08
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
*1
*2
Engine does not crank (Does not start)
6. Starter
7. Starter relay
No initial combustion (Does not start)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
3. ECM
No complete combustion (Does not start)
1. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
DI–86
Engine cranks normally (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
3. Compression
DI–113
DI–86
EM–3
Cold engine (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
DI–113
DI–86
Hot engine (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
DI–113
DI–86
High engine idle speed (Poor idling)
1. A/C switch circuit
2. ECM power source circuit
*3
DI–116
Low engine idle speed (Poor idling)
1. A/C switch circuit
2. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
*3
DI–86
Rough idling (Poor idling)
1. Compression
2. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
EM–3
DI–86
Hunting (Poor idling)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
DI–116
DI–86
Hesitation/Poor acceleration (Poor driveability)
1. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
2. A/T faulty
DI–86
DI–148
Surging (Poor driveability)
1. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
DI–86
Soon after starting (Engine stall)
1. Fuel shutoff valve circuit
DI–86
During A/C operation (Engine stall)
1. A/C switch circuit
2. ECM
*3
IN–29
A/C switch indicatior blinking
1. A/C Compressor lock sensor circuit
2. A/C Evaporator temp. sensor circuit
DI–119
DI–121
*1: See Pub. No. RM654U, page ST–2.
*2: See Pub. No. RM654U, page ST–20.
*3: See Pub. No. RM654U, page AC–84.
DI–116
DI–86
IN–29
DI–22
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00M–07
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
P0105
Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric
Pressure Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
V
Output Voltage
(3.96)
3.6
2.4
1.2
150
450
20
60
mmHg
750 (840)
kPa
100 (112)
By a built–in sensor unit, the manifold absolute pressure sensor
detects the intake manifold pressure as a voltage. The ECM
then determines the basic injection duration and basic injection
advance angle based on this voltage. Since the manifold absolute pressure sensor does not use the atmospheric pressure as
a criterion, but senses the absolute pressure inside the intake
manifold (the pressure in proportion to the present absolute
vacuum 0), it is not influenced by fluctuations in the atmospheric
pressure due to high altitude and other factors. This permits it
to control the air–fuel ratio at the proper lever under all conditions.
Manifold Absolute Pressure
P01242
DTC No.
P0105
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit
Open or short in manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0105, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the manifold
absolute pressure from the CURRENT DATA.
Manifold Absolute Pressure (kPa)
Approx. 0
130 or more
Malfunction
PIM circuit short
VC circuit open or short
PIM circuit open
E2 circuit open
DI–23
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
Manifold Absolute
Pressure Sensor
ECM
3
Y
1
VC
E5
2
B–Y
2
PIM
E5
1
BR
9
E2
E5
5V
E1
A00309
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120, P0180 and P0190 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of manifold absolute pressure.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
CHECK:
Read the value of the manifold absolute pressure on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Same as atmospheric pressure.
OK
NG
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
DI–24
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
ON
BE6653
A03008
E2
(–)
(+)
VC
A09254
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
OK
3
Check voltage between terminals PIM and E2 of ECM connector.
PIM
BE6653
A03009
(+)
(–)
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals PIM and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 3.3 – 3.9 V
E2
A09255
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
4
Check for open and short in harness and connector between manifold absolute
pressure sensor and ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Replace manifold absolute pressure sensor
(See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–52).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–25
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00N–06
DTC
P0106
Manifold Absolute Pressure Circuit Range/
Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0105 on page DI–22.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
After engine is warmed up, conditions (a) and (b) continue with
engine speed 400 – 1,000 rpm: (2 trip detection logic)
(a) Throttle valve fully closed
(b) Manifold absolute pressure sensor output > 3.0 V
P0106
Conditions (c) and (d) continue with engine speed 2,500 rpm or
less: (2 trip detection logic)
(c) VTA > 1.85
(d) Manifold absolute pressure sensor output < 1.0 V
Vacuum line
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120 and P0180 are output simultaneously, manifold absolute pressure sensor circuit may be open. Perform troubleshooting of DTC P0105 first.
If DTCs P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120, P0180 and P0190 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0106) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor operation (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–53).
OK
NG
Replace manifold absolute pressure sensor.
Check vacuum line between intake air chamber
and manifold absolute pressure sensor.
DI–26
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00O–07
DTC
P0110
Intake Air Temp. Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
(Fig.1)
30
20
10
Acceptable
Resistance kΩ
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
– 20
(– 4)
0
(32)
20
(68)
40
(104)
60
(140)
80
100
(176) (212)
Temp.°C (F°)
A09428
DTC No.
P0110
The intake air temperature sensor is built into the air cleaner
cap and senses the intake air temperature.
A thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value
according to the intake air temperature, the lower the intake air
temperature, the greater the thermistor resistance value, and
the higher the intake air temperature, the lower the thermistor
resistance value (See Fig.1).
The intake air temperature sensor is connected to the ECM
(See below). The 5 V power source voltage in the ECM is applied to the intake air temperature sensor from terminal THA via
a resistor R.
That is, resistor R and the intake air temperature sensor are
connected in series. When the resistance value of the intake air
temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in the
intake air temperature, the potential at terminal THA also
changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases the fuel injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine operation.
If the ECM detects the DTC P0110, it operates the fail safe function in which the intake air temperature is assumed to be 20°C
(68°F).
DTC Detecting Condition
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Trouble Area
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor circuit
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0110, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the intake
air temperature from the CURRENT DATA.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
–40°C (–40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
DI–27
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Intake Air Temp. Sensor
2
Y–B
3
THA
E5
1
BR
9
E5
5V
R
E2
E1
A00310
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120, P0180 and P0190 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of intake
air temperature.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Same as actual air intake temperature.
HINT:
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates –40°C (–40°F).
If there is short circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
NG
OK
Check for intermittent problems (See page
DI–3).
–40°C (–40°F) .... Go to step 2.
140°C (284°F) or more .... Go to step 4.
DI–28
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
ECM
5V
2
3
1
9
E5
E5
THA
E2
E1
A00391
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
(b) Connect the sensor wire harness terminals together.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Temp. value: 140°C (284°F) or more
OK
Confirm good connection at sensor. If OK, replace intake air temperature sensor.
NG
3
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
ECM
5V
3
E5 THA
9
E5
THA
A03010
E2
E1
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Connect between terminals THA and E2 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The intake air temperature sensor connector is disconnected.
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check for the
ECM connector (See page IN–29).
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
E2
A09256
OK
NG
Confirm good connection at ECM. If OK,
check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Open in harness between terminals E2 or THA,
repair or replace harness.
DI–29
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ENGINE
Check for short in harness and ECM.
ON
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
2
1
ECM
5V
3
E5
9
E5
THA
E2
E1
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the intake air temperature sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: –40°C (–40°F)
A00393
OK
Replace intake air temperature sensor.
NG
5
Check for short in harness or ECM.
ON
Intake Air Temp.
Sensor
ECM
5V
THA
E2
E1
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E5 connector from the ECM.
HINT:
The intake air temperature sensor connector is disconnected.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: –40°C (–40°F)
E5 Connector
A03011
A09257
OK
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–30
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00P–07
DTC
P0115
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value according to the
engine coolant temperature.
The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM is the same as in the intake air temperature circuit
malfunction shown on page DI–26.
If the ECM detects the DTC P0115, it operates fail safe function in which the engine coolant temperature
is assumed to be 80°C (176°F).
DTC No.
P0115
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0115, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the engine
coolant temp. from the CURRENT DATA.
Temp. Displayed
Malfunction
–40°C (–40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F) or more
Short circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Coolant Temp.
Sensor
5V
2
G–B
4
THW
E5
1
BR
9
E5
R
E2
E1
A00310
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120, P0180 and P0190 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
DI–31
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value of engine
coolant temperature.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Same as actual engine coolant temperature.
HINT:
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester indicates –40°C (–40°F).
If there is open circuit, OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester indicates 140°C (284°F) or more.
NG
–40°C (–40°F) ... Go to step 2.
140°C (284°F) or more ... Go to step 4.
OK
Check for intermittent problems (See page
DI–3).
2
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
ECM
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
5V
2
1
4
E5
9
E5
THW
E2
E1
A00395
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor connector.
(b) Connect the sensor wire harness terminals together.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
OK
NG
Confirm good connection at sensor. If OK, replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
DI–32
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE
Check for open in harness or ECM.
ON
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
2
ECM
4
E5
1
9
E5
5V
THW
E2
E1
THW
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Connect between terminals THW and E2 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The engine coolant temperature sensor connector is disconnected. Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure
check for the ECM connector (See page IN–29).
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F) or more
E2
A03012
A09258
OK
Open in harness between terminals E2 or THW,
repair or replace harness.
NG
Confirm good connection at ECM. If OK,
check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
4
Check for short in harness and ECM.
ON
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
ECM
5V
4
E5
9
E5
THW
E2
E1
A00397
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: – 40°C (– 40°F)
OK
NG
Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
DI–33
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE
Check for short in harness or ECM.
ON
Engine Coolant
Temp. Sensor
5V
THW
E2
E1
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E5 connector from the ECM.
HINT:
The engine coolant temp. sensor connector is disconnected.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the temperature value on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Temperature value: –40°C (–40°F)
E5 Connector
A03011
A09257
OK
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–34
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00Q–07
DTC
P0116
Engine Coolant Temp. Circuit Range/Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 on page DI–30.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
If THW < –7°C (19.4°F) or THA < –7°C (19.4°F) 20 min. or
more after starting engine, engine coolant temp. sensor value
is –10°C (–50°F)* or less (2 trip detection logic)
P0116
When THW 35°C (95°F) and 60°C (140°F), THA
–6.7°C (19.9°F) when starting the engine, conditions (a) and
(b) continue: (2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed is changing (Not stable)
(b) Water temperature change is lower than 3°C (37.4°F) from
water temperature since when starting the engine
Cooling system
Engine coolant temp. sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120, P0180 and P0190 are output simultaneously, engine
coolant temperature sensor circuit may be open. Perform troubleshooting of DTC P0115 first.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0116) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check thermostat (See Pub. No. RM654U, page CO–10).
NG
OK
Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
Replace thermostat.
DI–35
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00R–07
DTC
P0120
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A”
Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Throttle Position
Sensor
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and
detects the throttle valve opening angle. When the throttle valve
is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.3 – 0.8 V is applied
to terminal VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to the opening
angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 3.2 – 4.9
V when the throttle valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the
vehicle driving conditions from this signal input from terminal
VTA, and uses it as one of the conditions to decide the air–fuel
ratio correction, power increase correction and fuel–cut control
etc.
ECM
VC
VTA
E2
P24296
DTC No.
P0120
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
Condition (a) or (b) continues with more than 5 sec.
(a) VTA < 0.1 V
(b) VTA > 4.9 V
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0120, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the throttle
valve opening percentage.
Throttle valve opening position expressed as percentage
Throttle valve fully closed
Throttle valve fully open
0%
0%
Approx. 100 %
Approx. 100 %
T bl A
Trouble
Area
VC circuit open
VTA circuit open or ground short
E2 circuit open
WIRING DIAGRAM
Throttle Position Sensor
ECM
1
VC
E5
1
Y
3
LG
11
E5
2
BR
9
E2
E5
5V
VTA
A09396
DI–36
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120, P0180 and P0190 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor ground) may be open.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read the throttle
valve opening percentage.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the OBD II scan tool
or TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the throttle valve opening percentage.
OK:
FI7052
OK
Throttle valve
Throttle valve opening position
expressed as percentage
Fully open
Approx. 70 %
Fully closed
Approx. 10 %
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
NG
2
Check voltage between terminal VC of throttle position sensor connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal VC of the throttle position connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
ON
VC
(+)
(–)
A00369
NG
OK
Go to step 5.
DI–37
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE
Check throttle position sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–29).
NG
Replace throttle position sensor.
OK
4
Check voltage between terminals VTA and E2 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VTA and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
ON
VTA
BE6653
A09283
E2
(+)
(–)
A09264
NG
Throttle valve
Voltage
Fully closed
0.3 – 1.0 V
Fully open
3.2 – 4.9 V
Check for open and short in harness and connector in VTA and E2 circuits between ECM and
throttle position sensor (See page IN–29).
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
5
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
ON
E2
BE6653
A03008
(–)
(+)
VC
A09254
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–38
DIAGNOSTICS
OK
Check for open in harness and connector in
VC circuit between ECM and throttle position
sensor (See page IN–29).
–
ENGINE
DI–39
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00S–06
DTC
P0121
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch ”A”
Circuit Range/Performance Problem
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0120 on page DI–35.
DTC No.
P0121
Detection Item
Trouble Area
After vehicle speed has been exceeded 30 km/h (19 mph)
even once, output value of throttle position sensor is out of
applicable range while vehicle speed between 30 km/h (19
mph) and 0 km/h (0 mph) (2 trip detection logic)
Throttle position sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0121) being output?
YES
NO
Replace throttle position sensor.
Go to relevant DTC chart.
DI–40
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI1JU–04
DTC
P0125
Insufficient Coolant Temp. for Closed Loop
Fuel Control
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a three–way catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three–way catalytic converter, the air–fuel ratio
must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio.
The A/F sensor has the characteristic that provides output voltage* approximately proportional to the existing air–fuel ratio. The A/F sensor output voltage* is used to provide feedback for the ECM to control the air–
fuel ratio.
By the A/F sensor output, the ECM can determine the deviation amount from the stoichiometric air–fuel ratio
and control the proper injection time immediately. If the A/F sensor is malfunctioning, ECM is unable to perform accurate air–fuel ratio control.
The A/F sensor is equipped with a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is controlled by the
ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temp. of the exhaust gas is low), current flows to the heater
to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
*: The voltage value changes at the inside of the ECM only.
Platinum
Electrode
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platinum
Electrode
Heater
Coating (Ceramic)
ECM Monitored
A/F Sensor Voltage
Atmosphere
(V)
4.0
3.8
3.6
3.4
3.2
3.0
2.8
2.6
2.4
14 15 16
17 19 21 22
Air–Fuel Ratio
Cover
Exhaust Gas
A00477
DTC No.
P0125
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up, A/F sensor output* does not
change when conditions (a), (b) and (c) continue for at least
1.5 min.:
*: Output value changes at inside of ECM only
(a) Engine speed: 1,500 rpm or more
(b) Vehicle speed: 40 – 100 km/h (25 – 62 mph)
(c) Throttle valve is not fully closed
Trouble Area
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
Air induction system
EGR system
Fuel pressure
Injector
Gas leakage on exhaust system
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0125, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester to confirm voltage
output of A/F sensor from the CURRENT DATA.
The ECM controls the voltage of the AF+ and AF– terminals of the ECM to the fixed voltage. Therefore,
it is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
DI–41
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
9
J23 J/C
E
B–Y
B–R
2
5
Instrument
Panel J/B
W–R
2L 4
6
1
7
W–R
1
F9
B–G
FL
Block
2
2
MAIN FL
Battery
AF+
3.3V
4
1
7
IG1
B
IG3
G
2 HTAF
E4
5 OX2
E5
E04
3
Heated
Oxygen
Sensor
4 BR (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
IG3 12
IG3 A J20
A J/C
BR
1
F11
5 1K 3 1K
G
E1
B–W
BR
B
1 2A
B
EB
3
to Analog–Digital
Converter
A/F
Sensor
1
5
1B
6
E5
L
2
7 1W
4
W–B
2F
AM2
EFI
EFI
Relay
E
ECM
B
B
IGN
Engine Room R/B No.2
1
3
B
B–Y
J23 J/C
2K 7
2 2J
J18 J/C
P–B
B
B
B–R
B–Y
B–Y
IG1
IG Switch
B–Y
B–Y
P–B
14 AF–
E5 3.0V
21 HT2
E6
EC
E03
A09395
(*1)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If the vehicle run out of fuel, the air–fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0125 will be recorded. The MIL then
comes on.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0125) being output?
YES
NO
Go to relevant DTC chart.
DI–42
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value for voltage output of A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read the voltage value of the A/F sensor on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester
when you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of the AF+ terminal of the ECM is 3.3 V fixed and the A/F– terminal is 3.0 V fixed. Therefore,
it is impossible to check the A/F sensor output voltage at the terminals (AF+/AF–) of the ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage Value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle valve
open and close
Not remains at 3.30 V (0.660 V*)
V)
Not remains at 4.5 V (0.76 V*) or more
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is below 2.8 V (0.56
V*), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is above 3.8 V (0.76 V*), it
is normal.
If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.30 V (0.660 V*) even after performing all the above
conditions, A/F the sensor circuit may be open.
If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 4.5 V (0.76 V*) or more, even after performing all
the above conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 10.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
4
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (bank 1 sensor 1) (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–59).
DI–43
DIAGNOSTICS
NG
–
ENGINE
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
5
Check air induction system (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–1).
NG
Replace or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR system (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel shutoff valve operation (See page DI–86).
NG
Replace and repair.
OK
8
Check injector injection (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
9
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
DI–44
DIAGNOSTICS
NG
–
ENGINE
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1).
10
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–79).
Go
11
Is there DTC P0125 being output again?
YES
Check and replace ECM.
NO
12
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in past?
NO
YES
DTC P0125 is caused by running out of fuel.
Check for intermittent problems.
DI–45
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00Y–10
DTC
P0136
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0136
Voltage output of heated oxygen sensor remains at 1.0 V or
more, or 0.55 V or less when vehicle is driven at 40 km/h (25
mph) or more after engine is warmed up (2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heated oxygen sensor circuit
Heated oxygen sensor
HINT:
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farther away from the engine body.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P0136) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and heated
oxygen sensor (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check output voltage of heated oxygen sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the engine to normal operating temp.
DI–46
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
CHECK:
Read the voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor when the engine is suddenly raced.
HINT:
Perform quick racing to 4,000 rpm 3 min. using the accelerator pedal.
OK:
Heated oxygen sensor output voltage: Alternates from 1.0 V or less to 0.55 V or more.
OK
NG
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
Check that each connector is properly connected.
DI–47
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI00X–05
DTC
P0141
Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0141
When heater operates, heater current exceeds 2 A
(2 trip detection logic)
P0141
Heater current of 0.2 A or less when heater operates
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heater circuit of heated oxygen sensor
Heated
H t d oxygen sensor heater
h t
ECM
HINT:
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closer to the engine body.
Sensor 2 refers to the sensor farther away from the engine body.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check voltage between terminals HT2 of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
HT2
(+)
BE6653
A09296
(–)
A09265
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals HT2 of the ECM connector and body ground.
HINT:
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
OK
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–48
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE
Check resistance of heated oxygen sensor heater (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
SF–63).
NG
Replace heated oxygen sensor.
OK
Check and repair harness or connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and heated oxygen
sensor, and heated oxygen sensor and ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–49
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI1JW–04
DTC
P0171
System too Lean (Fuel Trim)
DTC
P0172
System too Rich (Fuel Trim)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared to the basic injection time. Fuel trim includes
short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim.
Short–term fuel trim is the short–term fuel compensation used to maintain the air–fuel ratio at its ideal
theoretical value.
The signal from the A/F sensor is approximately proportional to the existing air–fuel ratio, and ECM comparing it with the ideal theoretical value, the ECM reduces fuel volume immediately if the air–fuel ratio is rich
and increases fuel volume if it is lean.
Long–term fuel trim compensates for the deviation from the central value of the short–term fuel trim stored
up by each engine tolerance, and the deviation from the central value due to the passage of time and
changes of environment.
If both the short–term fuel trim and long–term fuel trim exceed a certain value, it is detected as a malfunction
and the MIL lights up.
DTC No.
P0171
P0172
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When air–fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on RICH side
(2 trip detection logic)
Air induction system
Injector blockage
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Air induction system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
ECM
When air–fuel ratio feedback is stable after engine warming up,
fuel trim is considerably in error on LEAN side
(2 trip detection logic)
Injector leak, blockage
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Ignition system
Fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe
Gas leakage on exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
ECM
HINT:
When the DTC P0171 is recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the LEAN side. When DTC P0172 is
recorded, the actual air–fuel ratio is on the RICH side.
If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air–fuel ratio is lean and DTC P0171 is recorded. The MIL then comes
on.
If the total of the short–term fuel trim value and long–term fuel trim value is within ±38 %, the system
is functioning normally.
The A/F sensor output voltage and the short–term fuel trim value can be read using the OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
DI–50
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
The ECM controls the voltage of AF+ and AF– terminals of ECM to the fixed voltage. Therefore, it is
impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester.
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air¯fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check air induction system (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check injector injection (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF−23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
3
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–53)
and engine coolant temperature sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–49).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
4
Check for spark and ignition (See page IG–1).
NG
Repair or replace.
DI–51
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
OK
5
Check fuel shutoff valve operation (See page DI–86).
NG
Replace or repair.
OK
6
Check gas leakage on exhaust system.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
7
Check output voltage of A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1).
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read the voltage value of the A/F sensor on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester
when you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of the AF+ terminal of the ECM is 3.3 V fixed and the AF– terminal is 3.0 V fixed. Therefore,
it is impossible to check the A/F sensor output voltage at the terminals (AF+/AF–) of the ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle valve
open and close
Not remains at 3.30 V (0.660 V*)
Not remains at 3.8
3 8 V (0.76
(0 76 V*) or more
Not remains at 2.8 V (0.56 V*) or less
*: When you use OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is below 2.8 V (0.56
V*), it is normal.
DI–52
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is above 3.8 V (0.76 V*), it
is normally.
If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.30 V (0.660 V*) even after performing all the above
conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be open.
If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 4.5 V (0.76 V*) or more, even after performing all
the above conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
8
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and oxygen
sensor (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Replace A/F sensor.
9
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–79).
Go
10
Is there DTC P0171 or P0172 being output again?
YES
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NO
11
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in the past?
NO
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
DI–53
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
YES
DTC P0171 or P0172 is caused by running out of fuel.
DI–54
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI64U–01
DTC
P0180
Fuel Temperature Sensor ”A” Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
(Fig.1)
30
20
10
Acceptable
Resistance kΩ
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
– 20
(– 4)
0
(32)
20
(68)
40
(104)
60
(140)
80
100
(176) (212)
Temp.°C (F°)
A09428
DTC No.
P0180
The fuel temperature sensor is built into the delivery pipe and
senses the fuel temperature.
A thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value
according to the fuel temperature, the lower the fuel temperature, the greater the thermistor resistance value, and the higher
the fuel temperature, the lower the thermistor resistance value
(See Fig.1).
The fuel temperature sensor is connected to the ECM (See below). The 5 V power source voltage in the ECM is applied to the
fuel temperature sensor from terminal THCNG2 via a resistor
R.
That is, resistor R and the fuel temperature sensor are connected in series. When the resistance value of the fuel temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in the fuel
temperature, the potential at terminal THCNG2 also changes.
Based on this signal, the ECM increases the fuel injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine operation.
If the ECM detects the DTC P0180, it operates the fail safe function in which the fuel temperature is assumed to be 20°C
(68°F).
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in fuel temperature sensor circuit for delivery
pipe
Fuel temperature sensor for delivery pipe
ECM
Open or short in fuel temperature sensor circuit
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0180, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the fuel temperature from the CURRENT DATA.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Fuel Temperature Sensor
for Delivery Pipe
2
1
P–B
BR
6
E7
5V
R
THCNG2
9
E2
E5
E1
A00310
DI–55
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120, P0180 and P0190 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor
ground) may be open.
1
Check voltage between terminals THCNG2 and E2 of engine ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals THCNG2 and E2 of the
ECM connector.
ON
E2
BE6653
A09295
THCNG2
(–)
(+)
A09298
Temperature °C (°F)
Voltage V
–20 (–40)
0.66 – 0.78
20 (68)
2.5 – 2.75
80 (176)
4.42 – 4.52
OK:
OK
Check for intermittent problem (See page
DI–3).
NG
2
Check fuel temperature sensor for delivery pipe (See page SF–42).
NG
Replace.
OK
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine ECU and
fuel temperature sensor for delivery pipe (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page SF–42).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–56
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI64V–01
DTC
P0190
Fuel Rail Pressure Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
By a built–in sensor unit, the fuel rail pressure sensor detects the intake manifold pressure as a voltage. The
ECM then determines the basic injection duration and basic injection advance angle based on this voltage.
Since the fuel rail pressure sensor does not use the atmospheric pressure as a criterion, but senses the absolute pressure inside the intake manifold (the pressure in proportion to the present absolute vacuum 0),
it is not influenced by fluctuations in the atmospheric pressure due to high altitude and other factors. This
permits it to control the air–fuel ratio at the proper lever under all conditions.
DTC No.
P0190
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in fuel pressure sensor circuit for delivery pipe
Open or short in fuel pressure sensor circuit for delivery pipe
Fuel pressure sensor for delivery pipe
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0190, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the fuel rail
pressure from the CURRENT DATA.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Fuel Pressure Sensor
for Delivery Pipe
ECM
3
Y
2
G–B
1
BR
1
VC
E5
5V
5
PCNG2
E7
9
E2
E5
E1
A00309
DI–57
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P0105, P0106, P0110, P0115, P0120, P0180 and P0190 are output simultaneously, E2 (sensor
ground) may be open.
1
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
ON
E2
(–)
(+)
VC
BE6653
A03008
A09254
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminals PCNG2 and E2 of ECM connector.
ON
E2
BE6653
A09293
PCNG2
(–)
(+)
A09297
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment.
(b) Start the engine (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–64).
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals PCNG2 and E2 of the
ECM connector.
OK:
Voltage: 3.1 – 3.6 V at 20°C (68°F)
HINT:
The fuel pressure in the delivery pipe is 784 – 1,078 kPa (8.0
– 11.0 kgf/cm2, 114 – 156 psi)
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between fuel pressure sensor for delivery pipe and ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–58
DIAGNOSTICS
OK
Replace fuel pressure sensor for delivery
pipe (See page SF–43).
–
ENGINE
DI–59
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI013–12
DTC
P0335
Crankshaft Position Sensor ”A” Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Crankshaft position sensor (NE signal) consists of a magnet, iron and pickup coil.
The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is installed on the crankshaft timing pulley. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals at every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the
G signal, and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE signal.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
P0335
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine
speed 600 rpm or more (2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position
osition sensor
Crankshaft timing pulley
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Camshaft Position Sensor
1
5
G
E6
B–W
2
L
1
B–R
B–R
4
NE+
E6
2
BR
L
17
NE–
E6
E1
Crankshaft Position Sensor
A09394
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Perform troubleshooting of DTC 335 first. If no trouble is found, troubleshoot the following mechanical
system.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
DI–60
DIAGNOSTICS
1
–
ENGINE
Check resistance of crankshaft position sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
IG–1).
G
G and NE Signal Waveforms
5 V/
Division
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
During cranking or idling, check the waveform between terminals G and G–, and NE and NE– of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The correct waveforms are as shown.
NE
20 msec./Division (Idling)
5 V/
Division
G
NE
A01991
A01992
NG
10 msec./Division (Idling)
Replace crankshaft position sensor.
A02359
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and crankshaft position sensor (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Inspect sensor installation (See Pub. No. RM654U, page IG–2) and teeth of crankshaft timing pulley (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EM–17).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Tighten sensor. Replace crankshaft timing
pulley.
DI–61
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI014–11
DTC
P0340
Camshaft Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Camshaft position sensor (G signal) consists of magnet, iron core and pickup coil.
The G signal plate has one tooth on its outer circumference and is installed on the camshaft timing pulley.
When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the signal plate and the air gap on the pickup coil change,
causing fluctuations in the magnetic field and generating an electromotive force in the pickup coil.
The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is installed on the crankshaft timing pulley. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals at every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the
G signal and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE signal.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM during cranking
(2 trip detection logic)
P0340
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM with engine speed
600 rpm or more
Open or short in camshaft position sensor circuit
Camshaft position
osition sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 on page DI–59.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check resistance of camshaft position sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
IG–1).
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
Refer to DTC P0335 on page DI–59.
NG
Replace camshaft position sensor.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and camshaft
position sensor (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–62
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
OK
3
Inspect sensor installation (See Pub. No. RM654U, page IG–9) and tooth of camshaft timing pulley (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EM–17).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Tighten
pulley.
sensor.
Replace
camshaft
timing
DI–63
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI64W–01
DTC
P0400
Exhaust Gas Recirculation Flow Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
←
The EGR system recirculates exhaust gas, which is controlled to the proper quantity to suit the driving conditions, into the intake air mixture to slow down combustion, reduce the combustion temperature and reduce
NOx emissions. The amount of EGR is regulated by the EGR vacuum modulator according to the engine
load.
If even one of the following conditions is fulfilled, the VSV is
turned ON by a signal from the ECM.
Throttle Body
This results in atmospheric air acting on the EGR valve, closing
the EGR valve and shutting off the exhaust gas (EGR cut–off).
Under the following conditions, EGR is cut to maintain driveabilThrottle
ity.
Valve
ECM
Before engine is warmed up.
EGR Valve
During deceleration (throttle valve closed).
Light engine load (amount of intake air very small).
Engine idling.
VSV
Engine speed over 4,400 rpm.
High engine load (amount of intake air very large).
EGR
Exhaust Gas
Vacuum
Modulator
P25430
DTC No.
P0400
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up, intake manifold absolute pressure
is larger than value calculated by ECM while EGR system is
ON (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Vacuum or EGR hose is connected to wrong post
Open or short in VSV circuit for EGR
VSV for EGR
EGR system
EGR vacuum modulator
EGR valve
Manifold absolute pressure sensor
ECM
DI–64
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
9
IG3
J18
J/C
B−Y
B
B
VSV
for EGR
B−Y
2
1
23
EGR
E6
P−B
E01
B−Y
B
W−B
From
Battery
1
2A
EFI 5
3
2
2J
4
2F
2
1
7
2K
B−Y
From
Ignition SW
EFI Relay
Engine Room J/B No.2
EB
A09397
SYSTEM CHECK DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
Idling
IG SW OFF
(6)
(3)
60 – 80 km/h
(38 – 50 mph)
(2)
(7)
(4)
(5)
(1)
Warm up
3 – 5 min.
2 min.
3 – 5 min.
2 min.
Time
P20769
(1) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Start and warm up the engine with all the accessories switched OFF.
(3) Run the vehicle at 60 – 80 km/h (38 – 50 mph) for 3 min. or more.
(4) Idle the engine for about 2 min.
(5) Do steps (3) and (4) again.
(6) Stop at safe place and turn the ignition switch OFF.
(7) Do steps (2) to (5) again.
(8) Check the READINESS TESTS mode on the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester.
If COMPL is displayed and the MIL does not light up, the system is normal.
If INCMPL is displayed and the MIL does not light up, run the vehicle again and check it.
HINT:
INCMPL is displayed when either condition (a) or (b) exists.
(a) The system check is incomplete.
DI–65
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
–
ENGINE
There is a malfunction in the system.
If there is a malfunction in the system, the MIL will light up after steps (2) to (5) above are done. (2 trip
detection logic)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTCs P0105, P0106 and P0400 are output simultaneously, perform troubleshooting of DTC P0105
first.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Check connection of vacuum hose and EGR hose (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check VSV for EGR.
Air
Air
E
G
E
Air Filter
System: OFF
G
System: ON
A00407
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
CHECK:
Check the operation of the VSV when it is operated by the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
EGR system is OFF:
Air from port E is flowing out through the air filter.
EGR system is ON:
Air from port E is flowing out port G.
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
3
Check operation of VSV for EGR (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–43).
DI–66
DIAGNOSTICS
NG
–
ENGINE
Replace VSV for EGR.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine room J/B No.2 and
ECM (See page IN–29).
4
Check EGR system (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check EGR vacuum modulator (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR valve (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
7
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–53).
NG
OK
Repair or replace.
DI–67
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
1
Check connection of vacuum hose and EGR hose (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check VSV for EGR.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E6 connector from the ECM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check the VSV function.
(1) Connect between terminal EGR of the ECM connector and body ground (ON).
(2) Disconnect between terminal EGR of the ECM connector and body ground (ON).
OK:
(1) VSV is ON:
Air from port E is flowing out through the air filter.
(2) VSV is OFF:
Air from port E is flowing out port G.
ON
E6 Connector
EGR
OFF
ON
Air
Air
E
E
G
Air
Filter
VSV is ON
G
VSV is OFF
OK
A09281
Go to step 4.
A09423
NG
3
Check operation of VSV for EGR (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–43).
NG
OK
Replace VSV for EGR.
DI–68
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
Check for open and short in harness and connector between engine room J/B No.2 and
ECM (See page IN–29).
4
Check EGR system (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
5
Check EGR vacuum modulator (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
6
Check EGR valve (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
7
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–53).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Repair and replace.
DI–69
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01B–12
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft, which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear. After this signal is converted into a more precise
rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted
to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
4–Pulse
4–Pulse
Vehicle
Speed Sensor
Combination Meter
ECM
Transaxle
Vehicle Speed Sensor
A00414
DTC No.
P0500
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
During vehicle is being driven, no vehicle speed sensor signal
to ECM (2 trip detection logic)
Combination meter
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Combination Meter
14
C11
5V
V–W
3
IF1
J15
J/C
V–W
V–W
B
B
9
SPD
E4
A09398
DI–70
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check operation of speedometer.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the speedmeter in the combination meter is normal.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
NG
Check speedometer circuit. See combination
meter troubleshooting (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page BE–2).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
(–)
BE6653
A09289
SPD
(+)
A09267
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Shift the shift lever to neutral.
(c) Jack up one of the front wheels.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal SPD of the ECM connector and body ground when the wheel is turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage is generated intermittently.
4.5 – 5.5 V
0
Turn the wheel
NG
AT7809
Check and repair harness and connector between combination meter and ECM.
DI–71
DIAGNOSTICS
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
–
ENGINE
DI–72
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI3A3–03
DTC
P0505
Idle Control System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is located on the throttle
body and intake air bypassing the throttle valve is directed to
the IAC valve through a passage.
In this way the intake air volume bypassing the throttle valve is
regulated, controlling the engine speed.
The ECM operates only the IAC valve to perform idle–up and
provide feedback for the target idling speed.
Intake Air
Chamber
Throttle Valve
From
Air
Cleaner
Signal
ECM
To Cylinder
Valve
IAC Valve
A01758
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in IAC valve circuit
IAC valve is stuck or closed
Open or short in A/C switch circuit
Air induction system
ECM
Open or short in IAC valve circuit
P0505
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from the target speed
(2 trip detection logic)
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
IAC Valve
10
E6
w
1
J18
J/C
B–Y
2
B
RSD
3
B
IG3 9
From
Battery
Driver Side J/B
3
7
IGN
1K
1W
From
IG Switch
1
2A
B
B–R
7
2K
EFI
2 1
EFI Relay
5
3
1
2
2
2J
B–Y
W–B
4
2F W–B
Engine Room R/B No.2
EB
EC
A09420
DI–73
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Check idle speed.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Switch off all the accessories.
(c) Switch off the A/C.
(d) Shift the transmission into the N or neutral position.
(e) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument panel.
(f)
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle and select the ACTIVE TEST
mode.
CHECK:
Check the difference of engine speed between the ones, less than 5 sec. and more than 5 sec. after switching the TE1 from OFF to ON by the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
Difference of engine speed: More than 100 rpm
OK
Go to step 8.
NG
2
Check for IAC duty signal.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument panel.
(b) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the IAC duty ratio on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
IAC duty ratio: 27 – 47 %
OK
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Go to step 3.
DI–74
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE
Check operation of IAC valve (See page SF–22).
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
4
Check blockage of IAC valve and passage to bypass throttle valve.
NG
Repair or replace IAC valve and throttle body.
OK
Go to step 8.
5
Check voltage between terminal 2 of IAC valve connector and body ground.
ON
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal 2 of the IAC valve connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
2
(+)
(–)
BE6653
A01553
A01584
NG
Check for open and short in harness and connector between IAC valve and J/B.
OK
6
Check for open and short in harness and connector between terminal 3 of IAC
valve connector and body ground.
NG
Repair or replace.
DI–75
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
OK
7
Check for open and short in harness and connector in RSD circuit.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace IAC valve.
8
Check for A/C signal circuit (See Pub. No. RM654U, page AC–84).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Check air induction system
(See page SF–1).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
1
Check idle speed.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature.
(b) Switch off all the accessories.
(c) Switch off the A/C.
(d) Shift the transmission into the N or neutral position.
(e) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument panel.
(f)
Connect the OBD II scan tool to the DLC3 on the vehicle.
(g) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
CHECK:
Check the difference of engine speed between the ones, less than 5 sec. and more than 5 sec. after connecting terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
OK:
Difference of engine speed: More than 100 rpm
DI–76
DIAGNOSTICS
OK
–
ENGINE
Go to step 8.
NG
2
Check for IAC duty signal.
PREPARATION:
(a) Warm up the engine normal operating temperature.
(b) Connect the oscilloscope between RSD of the ECM connector and body ground.
CHECK:
Check if IAC duty signal is output.
OK:
5 V /Division
GND
1 msec. /Division
HINT:
IAC duty ratio changes in response to engine operating condition.
OK
Go to step 6.
NG
3
Check voltage between terminal RSD of ECM and body ground.
ON
BE6653
A09303
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the lower center finish panel.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal RSD of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
RSD
(+)
(–)
A09648
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–77
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
NG
4
Check voltage between terminal 2 of IAC valve connector and body ground.
ON
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal 2 of the IAC valve connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 14 V
2
(+)
(–)
BE6653
A01553
A01584
NG
Check for open and short in harness and connector between IAC valve and J/B.
OK
5
Check for open and short in harness and connector in RSD circuit.
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace IAC valve.
6
Check operation of IAC valve (See page SF–25).
OK
Go to step 8.
NG
7
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal 3 of IAC valve connector and body ground.
DI–78
DIAGNOSTICS
NG
–
ENGINE
Repair or replace.
OK
Replace IAC valve.
8
Check blockage of IAC valve and the passage to bypass throttle valve.
NG
Repair or replace IAC valve and throttle body.
OK
9
Check for A/C signal circuit (See Pub. No. RM654U, page AC–84).
NG
OK
Check air induction system (See Pub. No.
RM654U, page SF–1).
Repair or replace.
DI–79
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01D–08
DTC
P1130
A/F Sensor Circuit Range/Performance Malfunction (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Voltage output* of A/F sensor remains at 4.5 V or more, during
engine running after engine is warmed up (2 trip detection logic)
*: Output value changes at the inside of ECM only
P1130
Voltage output* of A/F sensor does not change from 3.30 V,
during engine running after engine is warmed up (2 trip detection logic)
*: Output value changes at inside of ECM only
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
Air induction system
EGR system
Fuel pressure
Injector
ECM
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit (2 trip detection logic)
HINT:
After confirming DTC P1130, use the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester to confirm voltage
output of the A/F sensor (AFS B1 S1/O2S B1 S1) from the CURRENT DATA.
The A/F sensor’s output voltage and the short−term fuel trim value can be read using the OBD II scan
tool or TOYOTA hand−held tester.
The ECM controls the voltage of the AF+ and AF– terminals of the ECM to the fixed voltage. Therefore,
it is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand−held tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the TOYOTA hand−held tester.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
60 – 120 km/h
(38 – 75 mph)
Idling
IG SW OFF
(4)
(3)
(1)(2)
3 – 5 min.
Time
A00364
DI–80
DIAGNOSTICS
(1)
(2)
–
ENGINE
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Switch the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the normal mode to the check mode (See page
DI–3).
Start the engine and warm it up with all accessory switches OFF.
Drive the vehicle at 60 – 120 km/h (38 – 75 mph) and engine speed at 1,600 – 3,200 rpm for 3
− 5 min.
(3)
(4)
HINT:
If a malfunction exists, the MIL will light up during step (4).
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, detection of the malfunction will not be possible.
If you do not have a TOYOTA hand–held tester, turn the ignition switch OFF after performing steps
(3) and (4), then perform steps (3) and (4) again.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Are there any other codes (besides DTC P1130) being output?
YES
Go to relevant DTC chart.
NO
2
Connect OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, and read value for voltage output of A/F sensor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Warm up the A/F sensor with the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 sec.
CHECK:
Read the voltage value of the A/F sensor on the screen of OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester
when you perform all the following conditions.
HINT:
The voltage of the AF+ terminal of the ECM is 3.3 V fixed and the AF– terminal is 3.0 V fixed. Therefore,
it is impossible to check the A/F sensor output voltage at the terminals (AF+/AF–) of the ECM.
OK:
Condition
A/F Sensor Voltage Value
Engine idling
Engine racing
Driving at engine speed 1,500 rpm or more and vehicle
speed 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, and operate throttle valve
open and close
Not remains at 3.30 V (0.660 V
V*))
Not remains at 4.5 V (0.76 V*) or more
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester)
DI–81
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
HINT:
During fuel enrichment, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is below 2.8 V (0.56
V*), it is normal.
During fuel cut, there is a case that the output voltage of the A/F sensor is above 4.5 V (0.76 V*), it
is normal.
If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.30 V (0.660 V*) even after performing all the above
conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be open.
If the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at 3.8 V (0.76 V*) or more, even after performing all
the above conditions, A/F sensor circuit may be short.
*: When you use the OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester).
OK
Go to step 9.
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ECM and A/F sensor (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
4
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–59).
NG
Replace A/F sensor.
OK
5
Check air induction system (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–1).
NG
OK
Repair or replace.
DI–82
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE
Check EGR system (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
7
Check fuel shutoff valve operation (See page DI–86).
NG
Repair or repair.
OK
8
Check injector injection (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–53).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Replace A/F sensor.
9
Perform confirmation driving pattern (See page DI–79).
Go
10
Is there DTC P1130 being output again?
YES
NO
Check and replace ECM.
DI–83
DIAGNOSTICS
11
–
ENGINE
Did vehicle runs out of fuel in past?
NO
YES
DTC P0125 is caused by running out of fuel.
Check for intermittent problems.
DI–84
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01F–07
DTC
P1135
A/F Sensor Heater Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
When heater operates, heater current exceeds 8 A
(2 trip detection logic)
P1135
Heater current of 0.25 A or less when heater operates
(2 trip detection logic)
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor h
heater
t
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0125 on page DI–40.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check voltage between terminal HTAF of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
HTAF
BE6653
A09280
(–)
(+)
A09427
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal HTAF of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
2
Check resistance of A/F sensor heater (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–59).
NG
OK
Replace A/F sensor.
DI–85
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
Check and repair harness or connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and A/F sensor,
and A/F sensor and ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–86
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI64X–01
DTC
P1190
Fuel Pressure Regulator Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The fuel pressure regulator regulates the fuel pressure by reducing the pressure of the compressed fuel from
the fuel tank to the fuel injection pressure, which is 785 kPa (8 kgf/cm2, 114 psi).
Similar to the fuel shutoff valve for the fuel tank, a fuel shutoff valve is provided on the fuel inlet side of the
fuel pressure regulator to shutoff the supply of fuel when the engine is stopped or during abnormal conditions.
A reservoir that traps the moisture and oil in the fuel is provided on the low pressure side.
A built–in relief valve is provided to protect the parts located on the low pressure side.
While the fuel pressure is being reduced by the fuel pressure regulator, the Joule–Thompson effect
associated with the expansion of the fuel causes the fuel pressure regulator to be cooled excessively, exerting unfavorable influence on the rubber parts such as diaphragms and fuel hoses.
Therefore, to raise the fuel temperature, a water passage is provided in the fuel pressure regulator to allow
the engine coolant to warm the regulator.
DTC No.
P1190
DTC Detecting Condition
After engine is warmed up, detection of pressure control
malfunction (2 trip detection logic)
Trouble Area
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel tank
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel pressure
regulator
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator
Fuel fuel pressure regulator
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel delivery
pipe
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel delivery pipe
ECM
IG Switch
B–R
6
Instrument Panel J/B
3
7
IGN
1K
1W
R
8
B–R
7
2K
1
STARTER 3
1J
5
5
1B
1K
5
1
CIR
OPN
Relay
14 FC
E4
2
3
1
ST Relay
5 B–R
2D
11
GR
2J
MAIN
3
5
W–B
B
B–W
II2
II2
J/C
1
S1
1
S2
Starter
ID1
1
2
W–B
6
II4
Fuel ShutOff Valve For
Pressure Regulator
MAIN
FL
7
J8
IG
B–R
J7
1
2
A
Battery
L–B
6
GR C
L–B
5
B
10
Fuel ShutOff Valve
For Fuel Tank
J29
J/C
11
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
GR
B–W
L–B
B–G
B
L–B
B–W
A
ENGINE
G–R
J11
J/C
4
E7 VCNG3
5 EB1 EB1 4
–
1
1
L–B
2
ECM
1
L–B
B
1
DIAGNOSTICS
B
P
G–R
1
B
2A
3
B
2B
9
W–B 2K
B–Y
B–R
EB
EFI
1
1
F6
F4
FL Block
W–R
4
2L
B–Y
II3
4
W–B
2F
2
4
1K
AM2
W–R
EFI Relay
5
3
9
B–Y
Engine Room R/B
No.1
7
2
2J
10
2C
WIRING DIAGRAM
J19 Fuel ShutOff Valve
For Delivery Pipe
B J/CB 2
1
Engine Room J/B No.2
J40
J/C
Y–G
9
E7 VCNG2
13
E6 E01
BL
EC
DI–87
A09426
DI–88
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Check fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
CHECK:
Check the operating sound of the fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe for fuel tank when it is operated by the
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
HINT:
Use a sound scope or your finger to check the operating sound.
OK:
There is operating sound from the shutoff valve.
OK
2
Go to step 9.
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator and fuel shutoff valve for
fuel tank.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
CHECK:
Check the operating sound of the fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator and fuel shutoff valve for fuel
tank when it is operated by the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
HINT:
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator:
Use a sound scope or your finger to check the operating sound.
OK:
There is operating sound from the shutoff valve.
NG
NG
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator ...
Go to step 7.
NG
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank ... Go to step 4.
DI–89
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE
Check circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
SF–41).
NG
Replace circuit opening relay.
OK
4
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
FC
(–)
(+)
A09277
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment.
(b) Disconnect the E4 connector from the ECM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal FC of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage 9 – 14 V
OK
Go to step 5.
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN), and circuit opening relay and ECM (See page IN–29).
5
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank (See page SF–34).
NG
Replace.
OK
6
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) and fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank, and fuel shutoff valve for fuel
tank and body ground (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–90
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
OK
7
Check voltage between terminals VCNG2 and E01 of ECM connectors.
ON
E01
(–)
(+)
VCNG2
A09424
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VCNG2 and E01 of the
ECM connectors.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
8
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator (See page SF–30).
NG
Replace fuel shutoff valve with fuel pressure
regulator.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) and
fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator, and fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator
and ECM (See page IN–29).
9
Check voltage between terminals VCNG3 and E01 of ECM connectors.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment.
(b) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VCNG3 and E01 of the
ECM connectors.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
ON
E01
(–)
(+)
VCNG3
A09425
DI–91
DIAGNOSTICS
OK
–
ENGINE
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
10
Check fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe (See page SF–28).
NG
Replace.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and fuel shutoff
valve for delivery pipe, and fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe and ECM (See page IN–29).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
1
Check operation of fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank.
ON
OFF
A03030
ON
FC
A09432
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
SF–64).
CHECK:
(a) Connect between terminal FC of the ECM connector and
body ground.
(b) Check for operating sound from the fuel shutoff valve for
fuel tank when the ignition switch turned ON.
OK:
There is operating sound from the fuel shutoff valve.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–21).
NG
2
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–116).
NG
OK
Repair or replace.
DI–92
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE
Check circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
SF–41).
NG
Replace circuit opening relay.
OK
4
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM connector and body ground (See
page DI–86, step 4).
OK
Go to step 5.
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN), and circuit opening relay and ECM (See page IN–29).
5
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank (See page SF–34).
NG
Replace.
OK
6
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) and fuel shutoff valve for fuel tank, and fuel shutoff valve for fuel
tank and body ground (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–93
DIAGNOSTICS
7
ENGINE
Check voltage between terminals VCNG2 and E01 of ECM connectors.
ON
E01
–
(–)
(+)
VCNG2
A09424
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VCNG2 and E01 of the
ECM connectors.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
8
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator (See page SF–30).
NG
Replace fuel shutoff valve with fuel pressure
regulator.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) and
fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator, and fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator
and ECM (See page IN–29).
9
Check voltage between terminals VCNG3 and E01 of ECM connectors.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment.
(b) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VCNG3 and E01 of the
ECM connectors.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
ON
E01
(–)
(+)
VCNG3
A09425
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–94
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
NG
10
Check fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe (See page SF–28).
NG
Replace.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and fuel shutoff
valve for delivery pipe, and fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe and ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–95
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI64Y–01
DTC
P1240
Fuel Fuel Shutoff Valve Circuit for Delivery
Pipe Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P1190 on page DI–86.
DTC No.
P1240
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel delivery pipe
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel delivery pipe
ECM
Open in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel delivery pipe
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1190 on page DI–86.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Check fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
CHECK:
Check the operating sound of the fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe when it is operated by the TOYOTA
hand–held tester.
HINT:
Use a sound scope or your finger to check the operating sound.
OK:
There is operating sound from the shutoff valve.
OK
Go to step 5.
NG
2
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–116).
NG
Repair or replace.
DI–96
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
OK
3
Check voltage between terminals VCNG3 and E01 of ECM connectors.
ON
E01
(–)
(+)
VCNG3
A09425
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VCNG3 and E01 of the
ECM connectors.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
4
Check fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe (See page SF–28).
NG
Replace.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and fuel shutoff
valve for delivery pipe, and fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe and ECM (See page IN–29).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
1
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–116).
NG
OK
Repair or replace.
DI–97
DIAGNOSTICS
2
ENGINE
Check voltage between terminals VCNG3 and E01 of ECM connectors.
ON
E01
–
(–)
(+)
VCNG3
A09425
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Start the engine.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VCNG3 and E01 of the
ECM connectors.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
3
Check fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe (See page SF–28).
NG
Replace.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and fuel shutoff
valve for delivery pipe, and fuel shutoff valve for delivery pipe and ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–98
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI64Z–01
DTC
P1245
Fuel Fuel Shutoff Valve Circuit for Pressure
Regulator Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P1190 on page DI–86.
DTC No.
P1245
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel pressure regulator
Open or short in fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel pressure
regulator
Fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1190 on page DI–86.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Check fuel shutoff valve circuit for fuel pressure regulator.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
CHECK:
Check the operating sound of the fuel shutoff valve for the pressure regulator when it is operated by the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
HINT:
Use a sound scope or your finger to check the operating sound.
OK:
There is operating sound from the shutoff valve.
OK
Go to step 4.
NG
2
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–116).
NG
OK
Repair or replace.
DI–99
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE
Check circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
SF–41).
NG
Replace circuit opening relay.
OK
4
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
FC
(–)
(+)
A09277
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment.
(b) Disconnect the E4 connector from the ECM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal FC of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage 9 – 14 V
OK
Go to step 5.
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN), and circuit opening relay and ECM (See page IN–29).
5
Check voltage between terminals VCNG2 and E01 of ECM connectors.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VCNG2 and E01 of the
ECM connectors.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
ON
E01
(–)
(+)
VCNG2
A09424
OK
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–100
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
ENGINE
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator (See page SF–30).
NG
Replace fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) and
fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator, and fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator
and ECM (See page IN–29).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
1
Check for ECM power source circuit (See page DI–116).
NG
Repair or replace.
OK
2
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator (See page SF–30).
NG
Replace circuit opening relay.
OK
3
Check voltage between terminal FC of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
FC
(–)
(+)
A09277
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Disconnect the E4 connector from the ECM.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal FC of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage 9 – 14 V
DI–101
DIAGNOSTICS
OK
–
ENGINE
Go to step 4.
NG
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN), and circuit opening relay and ECM (See page IN–29).
4
Check voltage between terminals VCNG2 and E01 of ECM connectors.
ON
E01
(–)
(+)
VCNG2
A09424
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VCNG2 and E01 of the
ECM connectors.
OK:
Voltage 9 – 14 V
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
5
Check fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator (See page SF–30).
NG
Replace fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between circuit opening relay (Marking: CIR OPN) and
fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator, and fuel shutoff valve for fuel pressure regulator
and ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–102
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01G–07
DTC
P1300
Igniter Circuit Malfunction (No.1)
DTC
P1310
Igniter Circuit Malfunction (No.2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the ignition timing, turns on Tr1 at a predetermined angle (°CA) before the desired
ignition timing and outputs and ignition signal (IGT) 1 to the igniter.
Since the width of the IGT signal is constant, the dwell angle control circuit in the igniter determines the time
the control circuit starts primary current flow to the ignition coil based on the engine rpm and ignition timing
one revolution ago, that is, the time the Tr2 turns on.
When it reaches the ignition timing, the ECM turns Tr1 off and outputs the IGT signal O.
This turns Tr2 off, interrupting the primary current flow and generating a high voltage in the secondary coil
which causes the spark plug to spark. Also, the counter electromotive force is generated when the primary
current is interrupted, the igniter sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) to the ECM. The ECM stops fuel
injection as a fail safe function when the IGF signal is not input to the ECM.
DTC No.
P1300
P1310
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No IGF signal to ECM for 4 consecutive IGT1 signals during
engine running
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF or IGT1 circuit from No.1 ignition coil
with igniter to ECM
No.1 ignition coil with igniter
ECM
No IGF signal to ECM for 4 consecutive IGT2 signals during
engine running
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF or IGT2 circuit from No.2 ignition coil
with igniter to ECM
No.2 ignition coil with igniter
ECM
HINT:
No.1 ignition coil with igniter is for cylinder No.1 and No.4, and No.2 ignition coil is for cylinder No.2 and No.3.
DI–103
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
WIRING DIAGRAM
IG Switch
7
6 B–R
W–R
3
1K
5
1K
5
12
8
1C
5
1B
B–R IG3
W–R
Instrument
Panel J/B
B
2A
AM2
C
J9
J/C
B–R
No.1 Ignition
Coil with Igniter
1
C
Igniter
No.1
C
BR
2L
20
E6
IGT1
19
E6
IGT2
3
E6
IGF
Tr1
BR
Spark Plug
1
Igniter
No.2
B–G
J/C
A
A
BR
EC
BR 4
2
Tr2
W–R
3
No.2 Ignition Coil
with Igniter
Y–R
W–R
A
J18
W–R
1 F9
Battery
5V
3
Engine Room
FL Block J/B No.2
MAIN FL
B
2
Tr2
4
4
B–R
1 F11
1
ECM
Spark Plug
Tr1
A09399
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If DTC P1300 is displayed, check No.1 ignition coil circuit.
If DTC P1300 is displayed, check No.2 ignition coil circuit.
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame
records the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for
determining whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel
ratio was lean or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check for spark plug and spark of misfiling cylinder (See page IG–1).
NG
Go to step 4.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connector in IGF signal circuit between
ECM and ignition coil with igniter (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–104
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ENGINE
Disconnect ignition coil with igniter connector, and check voltage between terminal IGF of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
IGF
(+)
(–)
BE6653
A09288
A09269
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the ignition coil with igniter connector.
(b) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal IGF of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
OK
Replace ignition coil with igniter.
NG
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
4
Check for open and short in harness and connector in IGT1 and IGT2 signal circuits between ECM and ignition coil with igniter (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
5
Check voltage between terminals IGT1, IGT2 of ECM connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
SF–64).
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal IGT1, IGT2 of the ECM
connector and body ground when the engine is cranked.
OK:
Voltage: More than 0.1 V and less than 4.5 V
START
IGT2
IGT1
(+)
BE6653
A09287
(–)
A09268
DI–105
DIAGNOSTICS
IGT and IGF Signal Waveforms
2 V/
Division
IGT
0V
IGF
–
ENGINE
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
During idling, check the waveform between terminals IGT1 and
E1, IGT2 and E1, and IGF and E1 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The correct waveforms are as shown.
0V
NG
10 msec./Division (Idling)
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
FI6680
NG
6
Disconnect ignition coil with igniter connector, and check voltage between terminals IGT1, IGT2 of ECM connector and body ground.
START
IGT2
IGT1
(+)
(–)
BE6653
A09287
A09268
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the ignition coil with igniter connector.
(b) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals IGT1, IGT2 of the ECM
connector and body ground when the engine is cranked.
OK:
Voltage: More than 0.1 V and less than 5 V
OK
Replace ignition coil with igniter.
NG
7
Check ignition coil with igniter power source circuit.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the ignition coil with igniter connector.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal 1 of the ignition coil with
the igniter connector and body ground when the ignition switch
is turned to ON and STA position.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
ON
START
(–)
(+)
1
BE6653
A01761
A01861
NG
OK
Repair ignition coil with igniter power source
circuit.
DI–106
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
ENGINE
Check for open and short in harness and connector between ignition switch and
ignition coil with igniter (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Replace ignition coil with igniter.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–107
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI1K1–03
DTC
P1335
Crankshaft Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction (During engine running)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0335 on page DI–59.
DTC No.
P1335
DTC Detecting Condition
If conditions (a) through (c) are met:
(a) NE 1,000 rpm
(b) NE signal is not detected for over 50 msec.
(c) Not during cranking
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 on page DI–59.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to DTC P0335 on page DI–59.
Trouble Area
Open or short in crankshaft position sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Crankshaft timing pulley
ECM
DI–108
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01H–09
DTC
P1520
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This signal is used to detect when the brakes have been applied. The STP signal voltage is the same as
the voltage supplied to the stop lights. The STP signal is used mainly to control the fuel cut–off engine speed.
(The fuel cut–off engine speed is reduced slightly when the vehicle is braking.)
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Stop light switch does not turn off even once vehicle is driven
(2 trip detection logic)
P1520
Short in stop light switch signal circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stop Light
Switch
W
G–W
2
1
Instrument Panel J/B
A J27 J/C C
4
5
G–W
1R
1R
J23
J24
Light
Failure
Sensor
1 F9
R
B–R
MAIN
FL
W–B
FL Block
ALT
1 F14 2 F14
Battery
B–G
E4
STP
J34
J/C
7
1
2
1
A
2
High
Mount
Stop
Light
W–B
A
G–R
2
Stop
Light
(RH)
5 W–B
2
Stop
Light
(LH)
5
W–B
Instrument
Panel J/B
4 1B
B–R
G–W
2 1S
G–W
STOP
7 1C
ECM
4
BM
BL
A09400
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
1
Check operation of stop light.
PREPARATION:
Check if the stop lights go on and off normally when the brake pedal is operated and released.
NG
Check and repair stop light circuit
(See Pub. No. RM654U, page BE–37).
DI–109
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
OK
2
Check STP signal.
When using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the STP signal on the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
OK:
ON
Brake Pedal
Depressed
BE6653
Q06993
A09282
(–)
Brake Pedal
Released
(+)
STP Signal
Depressed
ON
Released
OFF
When not using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check the voltage between terminal STP of the ECM connector
and body ground.
OK:
OK
STP
Brake Pedal
Brake Pedal
Voltage
Depressed
7.5 – 14 V
Released
Below 1.5 V
Check for intermittent problems
(See page DI–3).
A09270
NG
3
Check harness and connector between ECM and stop light switch
(See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–110
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01I–12
DTC
P1600
ECM BATT Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Battery positive voltage is supplied to terminal BATT of the ECM even when the ignition switch is OFF for
use by the DTC memory and air–fuel ratio adaptive control value memory, etc.
DTC No.
P1600
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open in back up power source circuit
ECM
Open in back up power source circuit
HINT:
If DTC P1600 appear, the ECM does not store another DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room J/B No.2
B–G
1
F9
1
F11
B
1
2A
EFI
8
2J
B–Y
1
E4
BATT
FL Block
MAIN FL
Battery
A09401
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
DI–111
DIAGNOSTICS
1
ENGINE
Check voltage between terminal BATT of ECM connector and body ground.
LOCK
AB0117
A09286
–
(–)
(+)
BATT
PREPARATION:
Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
SF–64).
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal BATT of the ECM connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage 9 – 14 V
A09271
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
2
Check EFI fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room J/B No.2.
CHECK:
Check the continuity of the EFI fuse.
OK:
Continuity
Engine Room J/B No.2
NG
EFI Fuse
A00356
OK
Check and repair harness or connector between battery and EFI fuse, and EFI fuse and
ECM (See page IN–29).
Check for short in all harness and components
connected to EFI fuse.
DI–112
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01J–07
DTC
P1780
Park/Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it goes on
terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay thus the terminal NSW voltage
becomes 0V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the park/neutral position switch goes off,
so the voltage of ECM. Terminal NSW becomes battery positive voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal
power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air–fuel ratio correction
and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
2 or more switches are ON simultaneously for P, R, N, D, 2
and L positions (2 trip detection logic)
P1780
When driving under conditions (a) and (b) for 30 sec. or more
park/neutral position switch is ON (N position):
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 80 km/h (50 mph) or more
(b) Engine speed: 2,000 – 5,000 rpm
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P1780, use the TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the PNP switch signal from the
CURRENT DATA.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1780 on page DI–165.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Refer to DTC P1780 on page DI–165.
DI–112
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01J–07
DTC
P1780
Park/Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it goes on
terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay thus the terminal NSW voltage
becomes 0V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the park/neutral position switch goes off,
so the voltage of ECM. Terminal NSW becomes battery positive voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal
power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air–fuel ratio correction
and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
2 or more switches are ON simultaneously for P, R, N, D, 2
and L positions (2 trip detection logic)
P1780
When driving under conditions (a) and (b) for 30 sec. or more
park/neutral position switch is ON (N position):
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 80 km/h (50 mph) or more
(b) Engine speed: 2,000 – 5,000 rpm
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P1780, use the TOYOTA hand–held tester to confirm the PNP switch signal from the
CURRENT DATA.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1780 on page DI–165.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBD II scan tool. Because freeze frame records
the engine conditions when the malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting it is useful for determining
whether the vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up or not, the air–fuel ratio was lean
or rich, etc. at the time of the malfunction.
Refer to DTC P1780 on page DI–165.
DI–113
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01K–12
Starter Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, the intake air flow is slow, so fuel vaporization is poor. A rich mixture is therefore
necessary in order to achieve good startability. While the engine is being cranked, the battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM. The starter signal is mainly used to increase the fuel injection
volume for the starting injection control and after–start injection control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Instrument
Panel J/B
8
IG Switch
R
4
1K
3
1J
STARTER
5
7
1K
W–R
J29
J/C
B–W
B–W
B
B
11
IG2
Park/Neutral
Position Switch 10
5
6
IG2
B–W
GR
ECM
GR
C J/C B
J7
J6
5
1B
W–R
GR
11
STA
E4
B J6
E1
GR
B
B
1
2A
3
2B
11 2J
MAIN
FL
1 Block 1
F9
F11
AM2
4 2L
5
1
Engine Room
J/B No.2
ST
Relay
3
2
W–B
B–G
5 2D 9 2K
A
MAIN
FL
B–R
1
S1
1
S2
B–R
J9
J/C
Starter
Battery
IF
A03606
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
This diagnostic chart is based on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the engine is not
cranked, proceed to the problem symptoms table on page DI–21.
DI–114
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1
Connect TOYOTA hand–held tester, and check STA signal.
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the STA signal on the TOYOTA hand–held tester while the starter operates.
OK:
Ignition Switch Position
ON
START
STA signal
OFF
ON
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–21).
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and starter relay (Marking: ST) (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand–held tester):
1
Check voltage between terminal STA of ECM connector and body ground.
START
(–)
BE6653
A03027
(+)
STA
A09272
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal STA of the ECM connector and body ground, during the engine cranking.
OK:
Voltage: 6 V or more
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–3).
DI–115
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between ECM and starter relay (Marking: ST) (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–116
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01L–07
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery positive voltage is applied to the coil, closing the contacts of
the EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and supplying power to terminal +B of the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
B–Y
B
J23
J/C
B
J24
12
+B
E4
B–Y
B–R
2
4
2F
W–B
EB
Instrument
Panel J/B
3 1K
6
IG
Switch
16
E6 E1
4 2L
B
7
W–R
BR
1 2A
5
1B
5 1K
AM2
5
EFI
Relay
IGN
1
7 1W
B–R
3
Engine
Room
J/B No.2
W–R
7 2K
EFI
2 2J
1 F11
FL
Block
A
1 F9
J20
J/C
MAIN
FL
BR
A
B–G
Battery
EC
A09403
DI–117
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Check voltage between terminals +B and E1 of ECM connector.
1
ON
+B
E1
BE6653
A09291
(–)
(+)
A09273
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals +B and E1 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
Problem symptoms table (See page DI–21).
NG
2
Check for open in harness and connector between terminal E1 of ECM and body
ground (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–40).
NG
Replace EFI main relay.
OK
4
Check EFI fuse (See page DI–110, step 2).
NG
OK
Check for short in all harness and components
connected to EFI fuse.
DI–118
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ENGINE
Check for open in harness and connector between EFI main relay (Marking: EFI)
and battery, and EFI main relay and ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
6
Check IGN fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument panel J/B.
CHECK:
Check the continuity of the IGN fuse.
OK:
Continuity
IGN Fuse
Instrument Panel J/B
NG
A00355
Check for short in all harness and components
connected to IGN fuse.
OK
7
Check ignition switch (See Pub. No. RM654U, page BE–14).
NG
Replace ignition switch.
OK
Check for open in harness and connector between ignition switch and EFI main relay, and EFI
main relay and body ground (See page IN–29).
DI–119
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01N–05
A/C Compressor Lock Sencor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor sends 1 pulse par engine revolution to the ECM. If the number ratio of the compressor speed
divided by the engine speed is smaller than a predetermined value, the ECM turns the compressor off. And,
the indicator flashes at about 1 second intervals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
9
W–L
IJ2
10
W–L
18
W–L
IG3
LOCK IN
E6
1
A/C Compressor
Lock Sensor
2
10
BR
BR
IJ2
J7
J/C
6
BR
B
J20
J/C
B
IG3
16
BR
BR
A
A
E1
BR
A
E6
EC
A09404
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check A/C compressor.
PREPARATION:
(a) Check the compressor drive belt tension (See Pub. No. RM654U, page AC–16).
(b) Check if the compressor does not lock during operation with the engine started, and the blower switch
and A/C switch ON.
NG
OK
Adjust drive belt tension or repair compressor
(See Pub. No. RM654U, page AC–17).
DI–120
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE
Check A/C compressor lock sensor.
1
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the compressor lock sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure the resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of the compressor lock sensor connector.
OK:
Resistance: 65 – 125 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
2
N15622
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
During cranking or idling, check the waveform between terminals LOCK IN and E1 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The correct waveform appears as shown.
0.2 V/Div.
LOCK IN Signal Waveform
0V
NG
20 msec./Division (Idling)
Replace compressor lock sensor
(See Pub. No. RM654U, page AC–40).
N02774
OK
3
Check harness and connector between A/C compressor lock sensor and ECM
(See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–121
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI01O–05
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects the temperature inside the cooling unit and sends the appropriate signals to the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
5V
1
L–W
10
L–R
IG2
E5
THR
1
A/C Evaporator
Temp. Sensor
2
9
3
BR
BR
IG2
E5
E2
A09405
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals THR and E2 of ECM connector.
ON
E1
BE6653
A09290
THR
(–)
(+)
A09361
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals THR and E1 of the
ECM connector at each temperature.
OK:
Voltage:
2.2 – 2.6 V at 0°C (32 F)
1.4 – 1.8 V at 15°C (59°F)
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–122
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
NG
2
Check A/C evaporator temperature sensor.
Thermometer
Ice
Ohmmeter
Thermistor
More than
10 cm (3.94 in.)
AC0175
PREPARATION:
Remove the A/C evaporator temperature sensor (See Pub. No.
RM654U, page AC–30).
CHECK:
Check the resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of the A/C
evaporator temperature sensor connector at each temperature.
OK:
Resistance:
4.6 – 5.1 kΩ at 0°C (32°F)
2.1 – 2.6 kΩ at 15°C (59°F)
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
NG
Replace A/C evaporator temperature sensor.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between A/C evaporator temperature sensor and
ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–123
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI650–01
Fuel Pressure Sensor Circuit for Fuel Pipe
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0190 on page DI–56.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Fuel Pressure Sensor
for Fuel Pipe
ECM
1
VC
E5
3
Y
2
G–R
5
PCNG1
E7
1
BR
9
E2
E5
5V
E1
A00309
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals VC and E2 of ECM connector.
ON
E2
BE6653
A03008
(–)
(+)
VC
A09254
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals VC and E2 of the ECM
connector.
OK:
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
DI–124
DIAGNOSTICS
2
A09292
ENGINE
Check voltage between terminals PCNG1 and E2 of ECM connector.
ON
BE6653
–
E2
PCNG1
(–)
(+)
A09419
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals PCNG1 and E2 of the
ECM connector.
OK:
Needle position of fuel level gauge
Voltage (V) at 20°C (68°F)
4/4
3.3
3/4
2.7
2/4
2.0
1/4
1.3
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector between fuel pressure sensor for fuel pipe and ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Replace fuel pressure sensor for fuel pipe
(See page SF–46).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–125
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI652–01
Fuel Temperature Sensor Circuit for Fuel Tank
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A fuel temperature sensor that detects the temperature in the fuel tank is provided on the tank valve assembly. A fuel pressure sensor that detects the pressure in the fuel main pipe is provided immediately upstream
of the fuel pressure regulator.
The pressure and the temperature of the fuel are detected by these sensors and are input into the ECM.
Those values are then converted by the ECM into the equipment pressure at 20°C (68°F) to actuate the
the fuel gauge.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Fuel Temperature
Sensor for Fuel Tank
5V
3
4
LG–B
BR
4
IB1
LG–B
2
IB1
BR
2
IG2
LG–B
3
IG2
BR
1
E7
9
E5
R
THCNG1
E2
E1
A09421
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals THCNG1 and E2 of ECM connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals THCNG1 and E2 of
ECM connector.
ON
E2
BE6653
A09294
THCNG1
(–)
(+)
A09393
Temperature°C (°F)
Voltage V
–30 (22)
0.56 – 0.45
25 (77)
3.39 – 3.29
40 (104)
4.0 – 3.9
100 (212)
4.85 – 4.82
OK:
OK
Check for intermittent problem
(See page DI–3).
DI–126
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
NG
2
Check fuel pressure sensor for fuel tank (See page SF–40).
NG
Replace fuel pressure sensor for fuel tank.
OK
3
Check for open and short in harness and connector brtween ECM and fuel pressure sensor for fuel tank (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ECM (See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–127
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ENGINE
DI651–01
Injector Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
For the injection of fuel in the gaseous state, injectiors that allow the flow of a large volume of fuel and provide
improved sealing performance have been adopted.
These injectors are actuated by the voltage (150 V) that has been increased by the voltage booster circuit
provided in the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
+B
L
Injector
2
1
No. 1
B–W
BR
Injector
2
1
B–R
No. 2
G
Injector
2
R
1
No. 3
L
Injector
2
1
No. 4
BR
EC
EC
B–W
BR
A BR
A
2
E6
12
E6
1
E6
11
E6
15
E6
25
E6
14
E6
24
E6
13
E6
26
E6
Voltage
#10+
#10
Booster
Circuit
Voltage
#20+
#20
Booster
Circuit
Voltage
#30+
#30
Booster
Circuit
Voltage
#40+
#40
Booster
Circuit
E01
E05
J19
J/C
A09422
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check wire harness, connector and vacuum hose in engine room.
CHECK:
(a) Check the connection conditions of the wire harness and connector.
(b) Check the disconnection, piping and break of the vacuum hose.
NG
OK
Repair or replace, then confirm that there is no
misfire (See the confirmation driving pattern).
DI–128
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ENGINE
Check spark plug and spark of misfiring cylinder (See page IG–1).
NG
Replace or check ignition system
(See page IG–1).
OK
3
Check voltage of ECM terminals #10 – #40 for injector of failed cylinder.
ON
#10 #20
#30
BE6653
A09304
#40
(+)
(–)
A09431
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between applicable terminal of the ECM
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
Reference: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
With the engine idling, check the waveform between terminals #10 – #40 and E01 of the ECM connector.
HINT:
The correct waveforms are shown.
Injector Signal Waveform
(Magnification)
10 V/
Division
10 V/
Division
GND
GND
100 msec./Division (Idling)
Injection duration
FI6588 FI6538
1 msec./Division (Idling)
A00064
OK
NG
Go to step 5.
DI–129
DIAGNOSTICS
4
ENGINE
Check voltage of ECM terminalls #10+ – #40+ for injector of failed cylinder.
ON
#30+
–
#10+ #20+
#40+
(+)
BE6653
A09430
(–)
A09649
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page SF–64).
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between applicable terminal of the ECM
connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
HINT:
150 V is loaded on the injector at 100 msec. (in an instance)
when starting the engine.
OK
Go to step 5.
NG
Replace ECM.
5
Check resistance of injector of misfiring cylinder (See page IG–1).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
Check for open and short in harness and connector between injector and ECM (See page
IN–29).
6
Check fuel shutoff valve operation (See page DI–86).
NG
OK
Replace or repair.
DI–130
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
ENGINE
Check injector injection (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–23).
NG
Replace injector.
OK
8
Check EGR system (See Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–12).
NG
Repair EGR system.
OK
9
Check manifold absolute pressure sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–53)
and engine coolant temp. sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U, page SF–49).
NG
OK
Check compression pressure (See page *1),
valve clearance (See page *2) and valve timing (See page *3).
*1:
See Pub. No. RM654U, page EM–3.
See Pub. No. RM654U, page EM–4.
*1: See Pub. No. RM654U, page EM–23.
*1:
Repair or replace.
DI–131
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI02U–04
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manual, with the
page number indicated in the bottom portion. See the indicated
pages for detailed explanations.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–132
2
Connect an OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester to DLC3.
If the display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE” when you have connected the
scan tool / TOYOTA hand–held tester, inspect DLC3 P. DI–133
3 Check DTC and Freeze Frame Data (Precheck)
Record or Print DTC and Freeze Frame Data P. DI–133
4
Clear DTC and Freeze Frame Data P. DI–133
5 Visual Inspection
6 Setting the Check Mode Diagnosis P. DI–133
Symptom does not occur
8
7 Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–19
Symptom occurs
9
DTC Check
P. DI–133
10
DTC Chart
P. DI–145
OK Code 11
OK
Mechanical System Test
P. DI–133
OK 12
OK
Manual Shifting Test
P. DI–133
NG
NG
Problem Symptoms Table– P. DI–148
13
Chapter 1
(Electronic)
P. DI–148
NG
14
Preliminary Check NG
P. DI–133
Circuit
Inspection
Chapter 2
(On–Vehicle)
P. DI–148
OK
OK
Chapter 3
(Off–Vehicle)
P. DI–148
NG
NG
O/D Cancel Signal Check
O/D Main Switch & O/D OFF Indicator Light Circuit Check
15 Parts Inspection
P. DI–151 to DI–171
Identification of Problem
16
Repair
17
Confirmation Test
Author:
End
Date:
201
DI–132
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI02V–02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Transaxle Control
System Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
:
Registration No.
Customer’s Name
Registration Year
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem
Occurred
How Often Problem Occurs ?
/
km
mile
Odometer Reading
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
Vehicle does not move ( Any position
No up–shift
( 1st → 2nd
No down–shift
( O/D → 3rd
times a day)
Particular position )
2nd → 3rd
3rd → 2nd
3rd → O/D )
2nd → 1st )
Lock–up malfunction
Symptoms
Shift point too high or too low
Harsh engagement ( N → D
Lock–up
Any drive position )
Slip or shudder
No kick–down
Others
Check Item
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Normal
Remains ON
1st Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal code
Malfunction code (Code
)
DTC Check
DI–133
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI02W–05
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
FI0534
Hand–held Tester
DLC3
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Description
When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure
is that you connect an OBD II scan tool complying
with SAE J1987 or hand–held tester to the vehicle,
and read off various data output from the vehicle’s
ECM.
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle’s on–
board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the computer itself or
in drive system components which affect vehicle
emissions. In addition to the MIL lighting up when
a malfunction is detected, the applicable DTCs prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the ECM
memory (See page DI–14).
If the malfunction only occurs in 3 trips, the MIL goes
off but the DTCs remain recorded in the ECM
memory.
S05335
To check the DTCs, connect an OBD II scan tool or
hand–held tester to DLC3 on the vehicle. The OBD
II scan tool or hand–held tester also enables you to
erase the DTCs and check freeze frame data and
various forms of engine data (For instruction book).
DTCs include SAE controlled codes and Manufacturer controlled codes.
SAE controlled codes must be set as the codes prescribed by the SAE, while Manufacturer controlled
codes can be set freely by the manufacturer within
the prescribed limits (See DTC chart on page
DI–14)
DI–134
DIAGNOSTICS
–
(b)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode
during normal vehicle use, and also has a check
mode for technicians to simulate malfunction symptoms and perform troubleshooting. Most DTCs use
2 trip detection logic(*) to prevent erroneous detection. By switching the ECM to check mode when
troubleshooting, the technician can cause the MIL
to light up and for a malfunction that is only detected
once or momentarily.
(hand–held tester) (See page DI–145)
*2 trip detection logic:
When a logic malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is temporarily stored in the ECM memory.
If the same malfunction is detected again during the
2nd test drive, this 2nd detection causes the MIL to
light up.
Inspect the DLC3.
The vehicle’s ECM uses V.P.W. (Variable Pulse Width) for
communication to comply with SAE J1850. The terminal
arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and
matches the V.P.W. format.
DLC3
N09214
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 (Bus Line) – 5 (Signal ground)
During communication
4 (Chassis Ground) – Body
Always
1 Ω or less
5 (Signal Ground) – Body
Always
1 Ω or less
16 (B+) – Body
Always
9 – 14 V
Pulse generation
HINT:
If your display shows ”UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE”
when you have connected the cable of OBD II scan tool or
hand–held tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON and
operated the scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle side
or tool side.
If communication is normal when the tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect DLC3 on the original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tool
is connected to another vehicle, the problem is
probably in the tool itself, so consult the Service Department listed in the tool’s instruction manual.
DI–135
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
FI0534
Hand–held Tester
DLC3
S05335
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (NORMAL MODE)
Check the MIL.
(1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned
ON and the engine is not running.
HINT:
If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter
(See page BE–4).
(2) When the engine is started, the MIL should go off.
If the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system has
detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
(b) Check the DTC.
NOTICE:
(hand–held tester only): When the diagnostic system is
switched from normal mode to check mode, it erases all
DTCs and freeze frame data recorded in normal mode. So
before switching modes, always check the DTCs and
freeze frame data, and note them down.
(1) Prepare an OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or hand–held tester.
(2) Connect the OBD II scan tool or hand–held tester
to DLC3 at the lower portion of the instrument panel.
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON and turn the OBD II scan
tool or hand–held tester switch ON.
(4) Use the OBD II scan tool or hand–held tester to
check the DTCs and freeze frame data and note
them down (For operating instructions, see the
OBD II scan tool’s instruction book).
(5) See page DI–145 to confirm the details of the DTCs.
NOTICE:
When simulating symptoms with an OBD II scan tool (excluding hand–held tester) to check the DTCs, use normal
mode. For codes on the DTCs chart subject to ”2 trip detection logic”, turn the ignition switch off after the symptoms
have been simulated the 1st time. Then repeat the simulation process again. When the program has DTCs, the DTCs
are recorded in the ECM.
DI–136
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
3.
INSPECT DIAGNOSIS (CHECK MODE)
HINT:
Hand–held tester only: Compared to the Normal mode, the
Check mode has high sensing ability to detect malfunctions.
Furthermore, the same diagnostic items which are detected in
Normal mode can also be detected in Check mode.
(a) Check the DTC.
(1) Check the initial conditions.
Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
Throttle valve fully closed
Transaxle in P position
Air conditioning switched off
(2) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(3) Prepare a hand–held tester.
(4)
Hand–held tester
(5)
DLC3
S05335
(6)
0.13 sec.
Connect the hand–held tester to DLC3 at the lower
side of the instrument panel.
Turn the ignition switch ON and switch the hand–
held tester ON.
(7)
0.13 sec.
ON
(8)
OFF
BR3904
Switch the hand–held tester from Normal mode to
Check mode (Check that the MIL flashes).
Start the engine (MIL goes out after the engine
starts).
Simulate the conditions of the malfunction described by the customer.
NOTICE:
Leave the ignition switch ON until you have checked the
DTCs, etc.
(9) After simulating the malfunction conditions, use the
hand–held tester diagnosis selector to check the
DTCs and freeze frame data, etc.
HINT:
Take care not to turn the ignition switch OFF, as turning it off the
diagnosis system switches from Check mode to Normal mode,
so all DTCs, etc. are erased.
(10) After checking the DTC, inspect the applicable circuit.
DI–137
DIAGNOSTICS
(b)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Clearance the DTC.
The following actions will erase the DTC and freeze frame
data. Operating an OBD II scan tool (complying with SAE
J1978) or hand–held tester to erase the codes.
(See the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book for operating
instructions.)
4.
ROAD TEST
NOTICE:
Perform the test at normal operating ATF temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
(a) D position test
Shift into the D position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and and check the following points:
(1) Check up–shift operation.
1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D up–shifts take place, at the shift point shown in the automatic shift
schedule (See Pub. No. RM654U on page SS–54).
HINT:
O/D Gear Up–shift Prohibition Control (1. Coolant temp. is 50 °C (122 °F) or less. 2. If there is a 10
km/h (6 mph) difference between the set cruise control speed and vehicle speed.)
O/D Gear Lock–up Prohibition Control (1. Brake pedal is depressed. 2. Coolant temp. is 50 °C
(122 °F) or less.)
(2) Check for shift shock and slip.
Check for shock and slip at the 1 → 2, 2 → 3 and 3 → O/D up–shifts.
(3) Check for abnormal noises and vibration.
Run at the D position lock–up or O/D gear and check for abnormal noises and vibration.
HINT:
The check for the cause of abnormal noises and vibration must be done very thoroughly as it could also be
due to loss of balance in the differential or torque converter clutch, etc.
(4) Check kick–down operation.
While running in the D position, 2nd, 3rd and O/D gears, check to see that the possible kick–down
vehicle speed limits for 2 → 1, 3 → 2 and O/D → 3 kick–downs conform to those indicated on
the automatic shift schedule (See Pub. No. RM654U on page SS–54).
(5) Check abnormal shock and slip at kick–down.
(6) Check the lock–up mechanism.
Drive in D position, O/D gear, at a steady speed (lock–up ON) of about 75 km/h (47 mph).
Lightly depress the accelerator pedal and check that the engine speed does not change
abruptly.
If there is a big jump in engine speed, there is no lock–up.
(b) 2 position test
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points:
(1) Check up–shift operation.
Check to see that the 1 → 2 up–shift takes place and that the shift point conforms to the automatic
shift schedule (See Pub. No. RM654U on page SS–54).
HINT:
There is no O/D up–shift and lock–up in the 2 position.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the 2 position and 2nd gear, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine
braking effect.
DI–138
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(3)
Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration, and for shock at up–shift and
down–shift.
(c) L position test
Shift into the 2 position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check the following points:
(1) Check no up–shift.
While running in the L position, check that there is no up–shift to 2nd gear.
(2) Check engine braking.
While running in the L position, release the accelerator pedal and check the engine braking effect.
(3) Check for abnormal noises during acceleration and deceleration.
(d) R position test
Shift into the R position and fully depress the accelerator pedal and check for slipping.
CAUTION:
Before conducting this test ensure that the test area is free from people and obstruction.
(e) P position test
Stop the vehicle on a grade (more than 5°) and after shifting into the P position, release the parking
brake. Then, check to see that the parking lock pawl holds the vehicle in place.
Q00519
5.
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Check the fluid level.
HINT:
Drive the vehicle so that the engine and transaxle are at
normal operating temperature.
Fluid temp.: 70 – 80 °C (158 – 176 °F)
Only use the COOL range on the dipstick as a rough reference when the fluid is replaced or the engine does not
run.
(1)
OK if hot
Add if hot
AT3417
Park the vehicle on a level surface and set the parking brake.
(2) With the engine idling and the brake pedal depressed, shift the shift lever into all positions from P
to L position and return to P position.
(3) Pull out the dipstick and wipe it clean.
(4) Push it back fully into the pipe.
(5) Pull it out and check that the fluid level is in the HOT
range.
If the level is not within the range, add new fluid.
Fluid type: ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
NOTICE:
Do not overfill.
(b) Check the fluid condition.
If the level is not within the hot range.
DI–139
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Replace the ATF.
(1) Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid.
(2) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
Q00061
(3)
With the engine OFF add new fluid through the oil
filler pipe.
Fluid type: ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
Capacity: 2.5 liters (2.6 US qts, 2.1 Imp. qts)
(4) Start the engine and shift the shift lever into all positions from P to L position and then shift into P position.
AT8562
(5)
OK if hot
(6)
Add if hot
AT3417
With the engine idling, check the fluid level. Add
fluid up to the COOL level on the dipstick.
Check the fluid level is at the normal operating temperature, 70 – 80 °C (158 – 176 °F), and add as
necessary.
NOTICE:
Do not overfill.
(d) Check the fluid leaks.
Check for leaks in the transaxle.
If there are leaks, it is necessary to repair or replace O–rings,
gasket, oil seals, plugs or other parts.
(e)
Inspect and adjust the throttle cable.
(1) Check that the accelerator pedal is fully released.
(2) Check that the inner cable is not slack.
(3) Measure the distance between the outer cable end
and stopper on the cable.
Standard distance: 0 – 1 mm (0 – 0.04 in.)
If the distance is not standard, adjust the cable by the adjusting
nuts.
0 – 1 mm (0 – 0.04 in.)
AT4252
DI–140
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(f)
Q00199
Inspect and adjust the shift lever position.
When shifting the shift lever from the N position to other
positions, check that the lever can be shifted smoothly
and accurately to each position and that the position indicator is aligned with the correct position.
If the indicator is not aligned with the correct position, carry out
the following adjustment procedures.
(1) Loosen the nut on the shift lever.
(2) Push the control shaft fully rearward.
(3)
P
R
N
Q01561
Neutral Basic line
Groove
AT4478
Return the control shaft lever 2 notches to N position.
(4) Set the shift lever to N position.
(5) While holding the shift lever lightly toward the R
position side, tighten the shift lever nut.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(6) Start the engine and make sure that the vehicle
moves forward when shifting the lever from the N to
D position and reverses when shifting it to the R
position.
(g) Inspect and adjust the park/neutral position.
Check that the engine can be started with the shift lever
only in the N or P position, but not in other positions.
If it is not as stated above, carry out the following adjustment
procedures.
(1) Loosen the park/neutral position switch bolt and set
the shift lever to the N position.
(2) Align the groove and neutral basic line.
(3) Hold the switch in position and tighten the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in·lbf)
For continuity inspection of the park/neutral position
switch, see page DI–165.
(h) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed : 700 ± 50 rpm
(In N position and air conditioning OFF)
DI–141
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
6.
(a)
MECHANICAL SYSTEM TESTS
Measure the stall speed.
The object of this test is to check the overall performance of the transaxle and engine by measuring
the stall speeds in the D and R positions.
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
Do not continuously run this test for longer than 5 seconds.
To ensure safety, conduct this test in a wide, clear level area which provides good traction.
The stall test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe the conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
(1) Chock the 4 wheels.
(2) Connect an OBD II scan tool or hand–held tester to DLC3.
(3) Fully apply the parking brake.
(4) Keep your left foot depressing firmly on the brake pedal.
(5) Start the engine.
(6) Shift into the D position. Press all the way down on the accelerator pedal with your right foot.
Quickly read the stall speed at this time.
Stall speed: 2,450 ± 150 rpm
(7) Do the same test in R position.
Stall speed: 2,450 ± 150 rpm
Evaluation:
Problem
Possible cause
(a) Stall speed low in D and R positions
Engine output may be insufficient
Stator one–way clutch is operating properly
HINT: If more than 600 rpm below the specified value, the torque
converter clutch could be faulty.
(b) Stall speed high in D position
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch slipping
No.2 one–way clutch not operating properly
O/D clutch slipping
(c) Stall speed high in R position
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch slipping
1st & reverse brake slipping
O/D clutch slipping
(d) Stall speed high in D and R positions
Line pressure too low
Improper fluid level
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
DI–142
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(b)
Measure the time lag.
When the shift lever is shifted while the engine is idling, there will be a certain time lapse or lag before
the shock can be felt. This is used for checking the condition of the O/D direct clutch, forward clutch,
and 1st & reverse brake.
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operating fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
Be sure to allow 1 minute interval between tests.
Take 3 measurements and take the average value.
(1) Connect an OBD II scan tool or hand–held tester to DLC3.
(2) Fully apply the parking brake.
(3) Start the engine and check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm (In N position and air conditioning OFF)
(4) Shift the shift lever from N to D position. Using a stop watch, measure the time from when the
lever is shifted until the shock is felt.
Time lag: N → D Less than 1.2 seconds
(5) In the same manner, measure the time lag for N → R.
Time lag: N → R Less than 1.5 seconds
Evaluation (If N → D time or N → R time lag is longer than the specified):
Problem
Possible cause
N → D time lag is longer
Line pressure too low
Forward clutch worn
O/D one–way clutch not operating
N → R time lag is longer
Line pressure too low
Direct clutch worn
1st & reverse brake worn
O/D one–way clutch not operating properly
DI–143
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
7.
HYDRAULIC TEST
Measure the line pressure.
NOTICE:
Do the test at normal operation fluid temperature 50 – 80 °C (122 – 176 °F).
The line pressure test should always be carried out in pairs. One technician should observe
the conditions of wheels or wheel stoppers outside the vehicle while the other is doing the test.
Be careful to prevent SST’s hose from interfering with the exhaust pipe.
(1) Warm up the ATF.
(2) Remove the test plug on the transaxle case front left side and connect SST.
(See Pub. No. RM654U on page AX–17 for the location to connect SST)
SST 09992–00095 (09992–00231, 09992–00271)
(3) Fully apply the parking brake and chock the 4 wheels.
(4) Connect an OBD II scan tool or hand–held tester to DLC3.
(5) Start the engine and check idling speed.
(6) Keep your left foot pressing firmly on the brake pedal and shift into D position.
(7) Measure the line pressure when the engine is idling.
(8) Depress the accelerator pedal all the way down. Quickly read the highest line pressure when
engine speed reaches stall speed.
(9) In the same manner, do the test in R position.
Specified line pressure:
Condition
D position
kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
R position
kPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
Idling
362 – 422 (3.7 – 4.3, 53 – 61)
618 – 794 (6.3 – 8.1, 90 – 115)
Stall
735 – 862 (7.5 – 8.8, 107 – 125)
1,373 – 1,608 (14.0 – 16.4, 199 – 233)
If the measured pressure is not up to the specified value, recheck the throttle cable adjustment and retest.
Evaluation:
Problem
Possible cause
If the measured values at all positions are higher
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
If the measured values at all positions are lower
Throttle cable out of adjustment
Throttle valve defective
Regulator valve defective
Oil pump defective
O/D direct clutch defective
If pressure is low in the D position only
D position circuit fluid leakage
Forward clutch defective
If pressure is low in the R position only
R position circuit fluid leakage
Direct clutch defective
1st & reverse brake defective
DI–144
DIAGNOSTICS
Q00200
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
8.
MANUAL SHIFTING TEST
HINT:
By this test, it can be determined whether the trouble is within
the electrical circuit or is a mechanical problem in the transaxle.
(a) Disconnect the solenoid wire.
(b) Inspect the manual driving operation.
Check that the shift and gear positions correspond to the
table below.
While driving, shift through the L, 2 and D positions.
Check that the gear change corresponds to the shift position.
Shift Position
Gear Position
D
O/D
2
3rd
L
1st
R
Reverse
P
Pawl Lock
HINT:
If the L, 2 and D gear positions are difficult to distinguish, do the
above test.
If any abnormality is found in the above test, the problem is in
the transaxle itself.
(c) Connect the solenoid wire.
(d) Clear out the DTC (See page DI–133).
DI–145
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI02X–05
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a DTC is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table below and proceed to the page given.
* : ...MIL light up
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL *
Memory
P0500
(DI–151)
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
(No.1 Vehicle Speed Sensor)
Open or short in No.1 vehicle speed sensor circuit
No.1 vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
ECM
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0750
(DI–154)
Shift Solenoid A Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1)
Shift solenoid valve No.1 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0753
(DI–156)
Shift Solenoid A Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.1
ECM
P0755
(DI–154)
Shift Solenoid B Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.2)
Shift solenoid valve No.2 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0758
(DI–156)
Shift Solenoid B Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.2)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.2
ECM
P0770
(DI–159)
Shift Solenoid E Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Lock–up clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
P0773
(DI–161)
Shift Solenoid E Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL
ECM
P1520
(DI–164)
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
Open or short in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
P1780
(DI–165)
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Malfunction
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
DI–146
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI02Y–05
PARTS LOCATION
O/D Main Switch
O/D OFF Indicator Light
ECM
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Shift Solenoid Valve SL
DLC3
Stop Light Switch
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Shift Solenoid Valve No.2
Shift Solenoid Valve No.1
D00938
DI–147
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI64Q–01
TERMINALS OF ECM
E6
E5
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
E7
E4
6 5 4 3 2 1
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
FI6526
Symbols (Terminals No.)
S1 ↔ E1 (E6–7
(E6 7 ↔ E6
E6–16)
16)
S2 ↔ E1 (E6–6
(E6 6 ↔ E6
E6–16)
16)
SL ↔ E1 (E6–8
(E6 8 ↔ E6–16)
E6 16)
Wiring Color
V ↔ BR
L–B
L
B ↔ BR
P ↔ BR
OD1 ↔ E1 (E4–20 ↔ E6–16)
Y–B ↔ BR
OD2 ↔ E1 (E4–7
(E4 7 ↔ E6–16)
E6 16)
G O ↔ BR
G–O
L ↔ E1 (E4–19
(E4 19 ↔ E6–16)
E6 16)
Y ↔ BR
2 ↔ E1 (E4–18
(E4 18 ↔ E6–16)
E6 16)
L W ↔ BR
L–W
R ↔ E1 (E4
(E4–17
17 – E6
E6–16)
16)
R B ↔ BR
R–B
NSW ↔ E1 (E4–6
(E4 6 ↔ E6–16)
E6 16)
B W ↔ BR
B–W
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
IG ON
9 – 14
1st or 2nd gear
9 – 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
1st or 2nd gear
9 – 14
3rd or O/D gear
Below 1
IG ON
Below 1
Vehicle driving under lock–up position
9 – 14
IG ON
9 – 14
O/D main switch ON
9 – 14
O/D main switch OFF
Below 1
IG ON and Shift lever L position
IG ON and Shift lever other than L position
IG ON and Shift lever 2 position
IG ON and Shift lever other than 2 position
IG ON and Shift lever R position
IG ON and Shift lever other than R position
IG ON and Shift lever P or N position
IG ON and Shift lever other than P or N position
9 – 14
Below 1
9 – 14
Below 1
9 – 14
Below 1
9 – 14
Below 1
DI–148
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI030–05
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal code is displayed during the DTC check but the trouble still occurs, check the circuits for each
symptom in the order given in the charts on the following pages and proceed to the page given for troubleshooting.
The Matrix Chart is divided into 3 chapters.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Chapter 2: On–vehicle Repair Matrix Chart
Chapter 3: Off–vehicle repair Matrix Chart
If the instruction ”Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on matrix chart” is given in the flow
chart for each circuit, proceed to the circuit with the next highest number in the table to continue
the check.
If the trouble still occurs even though there are no abnormalities in any of the other circuits, then
check and replace the ECM.
Chapter 1: Electronic Circuit Matrix Chart
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
No up–shift
(A particular gear, from 1st to 3rd gear, is not up–shifted)
3. ECM
IN–29
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
1. O/D main switch & O/D OFF indicator light circuit
2. O/D cancel signal circuit
3. ECM
DI–171
DI–169
IN–29
No down–shift (O/D → 3rd)
1. ECM
IN–29
No down–shift
(A particular gear, from 3rd to 1st gear, is not down–shifted)
1. ECM
IN–29
No lock–up or No lock–up off
1. Stop light switch circuit
2. ECM
DI–164
IN–29
Shift point too high or too low
1. ECM
IN–29
Up–shift to O/D from 3rd while O/D main switch is OFF
1. O/D main switch & O/D OFF indicator light circuit
2. ECM
DI–171
IN–29
Up–shift to O/D from 3rd while engine is cold
1. ECM
IN–29
Poor acceleration
1. ECM
IN–29
No kick–down
1. ECM
IN–29
Engine stalls when starting off or stopping
1. ECM
IN–29
DI–149
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Chapter 2: On–Vehicle Repair
(: A140E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM385U)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Vehicle does not move in any forward positions and reverse position
1.
2.
3.
4.
Manual valve
Throttle valve
Primary regulator valve
Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Vehicle does not move in R position
1. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No up–shift (1st → 2nd)
1. 1–2 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No up–shift (2nd → 3rd)
1. 2–3 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
1. 3–4 shift valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No down–shift (O/D → 3rd)
1. 3–4 shift valve
No down–shift (3rd → 2nd)
1. 2–3 shift valve
No down–shift (2nd → 1st)
1. 1–2 shift valve
No lock–up or No lock–up off
1. Lock–up relay valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1. C1 accumulator
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Harsh engagement (N → R)
1. C2 accumulator
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Harsh engagement (N → L)
1. Low coast modulator valve
Harsh engagement (Lock–up)
1. Lock–up relay valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
Harsh engagement (1st → 2nd → 3rd → O/D)
1. Throttle modulator valve
2. Cut back valve
3. Throttle valve
Harsh engagement (2nd → 3rd)
1. C2 accumulator
Harsh engagement (3rd → O/D)
1. B0 accumulator
Harsh engagement (O/D → 3rd)
1. C0 accumulator
2. B0 accumulator
Slip or shudder (Forward and reverse)
1. Throttle valve
2. Oil strainer
3. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No engine braking (1st: L position)
1. Low coast modulator valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No engine braking (2nd: 2 position)
1. 2nd coast modulator valve
2. Off–vehicle repair matrix chart
–
No kick–down
1. 1–2 shift valve
2. 2–3 shift valve
3. 3–4 shift valve
DI–150
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Chapter 3: Off–Vehicle Repair
(: A140E AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE Repair Manual Pub. No. RM385U)
(*: 1999 CAMRY Repair Manual Pub. No. RM654U AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E) Section)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Vehicle does not move in any forward positions and reverse position
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Front and rear planetary gear
O/D planetary gear
O/D one–way clutch (F0)
O/D direct clutch (C0)
O/D brake (B0)
Forward clutch (C1)
Vehicle does not move in R position
1.
2.
3.
4.
Front and rear planetary gear unit
Direct clutch (C2)
O/D direct clutch (C0)
1st & reverse brake (B3)
No up–shift (1st → 2nd)
1. No. 1 one–way clutch (F1)
2. 2nd brake (B2)
No up–shift (2nd → 3rd)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
No up–shift (3rd → O/D)
1. O/D brake (B0)
No lock–up or No lock–up off
1. Torque converter clutch
Harsh engagement (N → D)
1. Forward clutch (C1)
2. O/D one–way clutch (F0)
3. No. 2 one–way clutch (F2)
Harsh engagement (N → R)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
2. 1st & reverse brake (B3)
Harsh engagement (Lock–up)
1. Torque converter clutch
*AX–26
Slip or shudder (Forward position: After warm–up)
1.
2.
3.
4.
*AX–26
Slip or shudder (R position)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
2. 1st & reverse brake (B3)
3. O/D direct clutch (C0)
Slip or shudder (1st)
1. No. 2 one–way clutch (F2)
Slip or shudder (2nd)
1. No. 1 one–way clutch (F1)
2. 2nd brake (B2)
Slip or shudder (3rd)
1. Direct clutch (C2)
Slip or shudder (O/D)
1. O/D brake (B0)
No engine braking (1st ∼ 3rd: D position)
1. 2nd brake (B2)
No engine braking (1st: L position)
1. 1st & reverse brake (B3)
No engine braking (2nd: 2 position)
1. 2nd coast brake (B1)
Poor acceleration (All positions)
1. Torque converter clutch
2. O/D planetary gear
Poor acceleration (O/D)
1. O/D direct clutch (C0)
2. O/D planetary gear
Large shift shock or engine stalls when starting off or stopping
1. Torque converter clutch
Torque converter clutch
O/D direct clutch (C0)
Forward clutch (C1)
O/D one–way clutch (F0)
*AX–26
*AX–26
*AX–26
DI–151
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI1J0–02
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4–pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft, which is rotated
by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear. After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular wave form by the wave form shaping circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the
ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pluse signals.
4–Pulse
4–Pulse
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Combination Meter
ECM
Transaxle
Vehicle Speed Sensor
A00414
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0500
During vehicle is being driven, no vehicle speed sensor signal
to ECM
(2 trip detection logic)
Clutch or brake slips or gear is broken
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–69.
Trouble Area
Combination meter
Open or short in vehicle speed sensor circuit
Vehicle speed sensor
ECM
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
DI–152
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of speedometer.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle and check if the operation of the speedmeter in the combination meter is normal.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is operating normally if the speedometer display is normal.
NG
Check speedometer circuit. See combination
meter troubleshooting (See page BE–4).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and body ground.
ON
SPD
D06505
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove glove compartment (See Pub. No. RM654U on
page BO–75).
(b) Shift the shift lever to neutral.
(c) Jack up one of the front wheels.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal SPD of ECM connector and
body ground when the wheel is turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage is generated intermittently.
4.5 ∼ 5.5 V
0
Turn the wheel
NG
OK
AT7809
Check and repair harness and connector between combination meter and ECM (See page
IN–29).
DI–153
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Check the ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and repair the transaxle (clutch, brake
or gear etc.).
Replace the ECM.
DI–154
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI032–05
DTC
P0750, P0755
Shift Solenoid A/B Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve No.1/No.2)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses signals from the vehicle speed sensor and crankshaft position sensor to detect the actual
gear position (1st, 2nd, 3rd or O/D gear).
Then the ECM compares the actual gear with the shift schedule in the ECM memory to detect mechanical
trouble of the shift solenoid valves, valve body or automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.).
DTC No.
P0750
P0755
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
During normal driving, the gear required by the ECM does not
match the actual gear
(2 trip detection logic)
Shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2 is stuck open or closed
Valve body is blocked up or stuck
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
Check the shift solenoid valve No.1 when DTC P0750 is output and check the shift solenoid valve No.2 when
DTC P0755 is output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2 operation.
Q07741
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the oil pan.
(b) Remove the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
CHECK:
(a) By applying 490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) of compressed
air, check that the solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) When battery positive voltage is supplied to the shift solenoid valve, check that the valve opens.
OK:
(a) Solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) Solenoid valve opens.
NG
OK
Replace the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
DI–155
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Check the valve body (See page DI–148).
NG
OK
Repair or replace the transaxle.
Repair or replace the valve body.
DI–156
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI033–05
DTC
P0753, P0758
Shift Solenoid A/B Electrical Malfunction (Shift Solenoid Valve No.1/No.2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Shifting from 1st to O/D is performed in combination with ON and OFF of the shift solenoid valves No.1 and
No.2 controlled by ECM. If an open or short circuit occurs in either of the shift solenoid valves, the ECM controls the remaining normal shift solenoid valve to allow the vehicle to be operated smoothly (Fail safe function).
Fail Safe Function:
If either of the shift solenoid valve circuits develops an open or short, the ECM turns the other shift solenoid
ON and OFF to shift to the gear positions shown in the table below. The ECM also turns the shift solenoid
valve SL OFF at the same time. If both solenoids are malfunction, hydraulic control cannot be performed
electronically and must be done manually.
Manual shifting as shown in the following table must be done (In the case of a short circuit, the ECM stops
sending current to the short circuited solenoid).
SHIFT SOLENOID NO.1
MALFUNCTIONING
NORMAL
Position
D
2
L
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
ON
OFF
ON
Gear
1st
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
ON
X
ON
2nd
X
OFF
ON
3rd
X
OFF
OFF
O/D
X
SHIFT SOLENOID NO.2
MALFUNCTIONING
Gear
BOTH SOLENOIDS MALFUNCTIONING
Gear when shift selector is
manually operated
3rd
Solenoid valve
No.1
No.2
X
ON
1st
O/D
3rd
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
ON
3rd
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
OFF
O/D
OFF
X
O/D
O/D
3rd
ON
X
1st
3rd
3rd
OFF
X
3rd
3rd
ON
Gear
ON
OFF
1st
X
ON
ON
ON
2nd
X
ON
OFF
ON
3rd
X
ON
3rd
OFF
X
3rd
3rd
ON
OFF
1st
X
OFF
1st
ON
X
1st
1st
ON
ON
2nd
X
ON
2nd
ON
X
1st
1st
X: Malfunctions
Check the shift solenoid valve No.1 when DTC P0753 is output and check the shift solenoid valve No.2 when
DTC P0758 is output.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
P0753
P0758
The ECM checks for an open or short circuit in the shift solenoid valves No.1 and No.2 circuit when it changes gear position.
The ECM records DTC P0753 or P0758 if condition (a) or (b) is
detected once, but it does not light up MIL.
After 1 sec. ECM detects condition (a) or (b) in a trip again, it
causes the MIL to light up.
(a) When the solenoid is energized, the solenoid resistance is
8 Ω or less and is counted.
(b) When the solenoid is not energized, the solenoid resistance
is 100 kΩ or more and is counted.
Trouble Area
Open or short in shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2 circuit
Shift solenoid valve No.1/No.2
ECM
DI–157
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transaxle
Shift Solenoid
Valve No. 1
Shift Solenoid
Valve No. 2
ECM
B+
3
E2
1
E2
7
E6
V
L–B
Junction
Connector
B
B
19
19
S1
B+
L–B
6
E6
S2
B 19
from Cruise
Control ECU
D01841
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Measure resistance between terminal S1 or S2 of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from ECM.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal S1 or S2 of ECM and
body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 11 – 15 Ω
S1
S2
D05157
OK
NG
Check and replace the ECM.
DI–158
DIAGNOSTICS
2
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Check harness and connector between ECM and automatic transaxle solenoid
connector.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the solenoid connector from the automatic transaxle.
CHECK:
Check the harness and connector between terminal S1 or S2
of ECM and terminal S1 or S2 of solenoid connector.
OK:
There is no open and no short circuit.
S2
S2
–
S1
S1
D05156
NG
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
OK
3
Check shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the oil pan.
(c) Disconnect the solenoid connector.
(d) Remove the shift solenoid valve No.1 or No.2.
CHECK:
(a) Measure resistance between solenoid connector and
body ground.
(b) Connect the positive lead to terminal of solenoid connector, negative lead to solenoid body.
OK:
(a) Resistance: 11 – 15 Ω
(b) The solenoid makes an operating noise.
Q07744
NG
OK
Repair or replace the solenoid wire.
Replace the shift solenoid valve.
DI–159
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI034–05
DTC
P0770
Shift Solenoid E Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Drain
Line
Pressure
Drain
Q07745
The ECM uses the signals from the throttle position sensor, air–
flow meter and crankshaft position sensor to monitor the engagement condition of the lock–up clutch.
Then the ECM compares the engagement condition of the
lock–up clutch with the lock–up schedule in the ECM memory
to detect mechanical trouble of the shift solenoid valve SL,
valve body, torque converter clutch or automatic transaxle
(clutch, brake or gear etc.).
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
P0770
Lock–up does not occur when driving in the lock–up range
(normal driving at 80 km/h [50 mph]), or lock–up remains ON
in the lock–up OFF range.
(2 trip detection logic)
When lock–up is ON, clutch or brake slips or gear is broken.
Shift solenoid valve SL is stuck open or closed
Valve body blocked up or stuck
Lock–up clutch
Automatic transaxle (clutch, brake or gear etc.)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check solenoid valve SL operation.
Q07746
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the oil pan.
(b) Remove the shift solenoid valve SL.
CHECK:
(a) By applying 490 kPa (5 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) of compressed
air, check that the solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) When battery positive voltage is supplied to the shift solenoid valve, check that the solenoid valve opens.
OK:
(a) Solenoid valve does not leak air.
(b) Solenoid valve opens.
NG
OK
Replace the solenoid valve SL.
DI–160
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Check valve body (See page DI–148).
NG
Repair or replace the valve body.
OK
3
Check the torque converter clutch (See Pub. No. RM654U on page AX–26).
NG
OK
Repair or replace the transaxle.
Replace the torque converter clutch.
DI–161
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI035–05
DTC
P0773
Shift Solenoid E Electrical Malfunction
(Shift Solenoid Valve SL)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The shift solenoid valve SL is turned ON and OFF by signals from the ECM to control the hydraulic pressure
acting on the lock–up relay valve, which then controls operation of the lock–up clutch.
Fail safe function
If the ECM detects a malfunction, it turns the shift solenoid valve SL OFF.
DTC No.
P0773
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Either (a) or (b) is detected for 1 time.(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Solenoid resistance is 8 Ω or less short circuit when solenoid is energized.
(b) Solenoid resistance is 100 kΩ or more open circuit when
solenoid is not energized.
Open or short in shift solenoid valve SL circuit
Shift solenoid valve SL
ECM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transaxle
Shift Solenoid
Valve SL
ECM
1
E1
P
8
E6
SL
D02260
DI–162
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Measure resistance between terminal SL of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from ECM.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal SL of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
Resistance: 11 – 15 Ω
SL
D05155
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
NG
2
Check harness and connector between ECM and automatic transaxle solenoid
connector.
SL
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the solenoid connector from the transaxle.
CHECK:
Check the harness and connector between terminal SL of ECM
and terminal SL of solenoid connector.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
1
2
SL
D05154
NG
OK
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
DI–163
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Check shift solenoid valve SL.
Q07749
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the oil pan.
(c) Disconnect the shift solenoid valve SL connector.
(d) Remove the shift solenoid valve SL.
CHECK:
(a) Measure resistance between terminal SL of shift solenoid
valve and solenoid body.
(b) Connect positive lead to terminal of solenoid connector, negative lead to solenoid body.
OK:
(a) Resistance: 11 – 15 Ω
(b) The shift solenoid valve SL makes operation
noise.
NG
OK
Check and replace or repair the solenoid
wire.
Replace the shift solenoid valve SL.
DI–164
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI036–05
DTC
P1520
Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The purpose of this circuit is to prevent the engine from stalling, while driving in lock–up condition, when
brakes are suddenly applied.
When the brake pedal is depressed, this switch sends a signal to ECM. Then the ECM cancels operation
of the lock–up clutch while braking is in progress.
DTC No.
P1520
DTC Detecting Condition
No stop light switch signal to ECM during driving.
(2 trip detection logic)
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–108.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
See page DI–108.
Trouble Area
Open or short in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
ECM
DI–165
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI037–05
DTC
P1780
Park/Neutral Position Switch Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch detects the shift lever position and sends signals to the ECM.
The ECM receives signals (NSW, R, 2 and L) from the park/neutral position switch. When the signal is not
sent to the ECM from the park/neutral position switch, the ECM judges that the shift lever is in D position.
DTC No.
P1780
DTC Detection Condition
When driving under conditions (a) and (b) for 30 seconds or
more, the park/neutral position switch is ON (N position).
(2 trip detection logic)
(a) Vehicle speed: 80 km/h (50 mph) or more
(b) Engine speed: 2,000 – 5,000 rpm
Trouble Area
Short in park/neutral position switch circuit
Park/neutral position switch
ECM
DI–166
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination
Meter
8
R
C10
11
2
C10
L
ECM
R–B
6
C10
O
13
IF1
Y
16
IF1
L–W
Park/Neutral
Position Switch
LL
J19
Junction
Connector 2 RB
P1
D
R–L
4
P1
Y
5
IG2
Y
J22
Junction
Connector E
E
E
1V 5
Y
19
E4
L
L–W
18
E4
2
R–B
J22 Junction
Connector
D
2L 3 L–W 6
P1
IG2
D R–L
RL
8
P1
3
IG3
R–B
2 IG2
6
F R–L P1 N
GR
P
5
P1
F
11
IG2
B–W
R–L
J24 Junction
Connector
B–R
Instrument
Panel J/B
1H 10
1
1B
AM1
2
1K
W
D
D
C J27
17
C
A
R
R–B
J23
J24
E4
R–B
Junction
Connector
B–W
B–W
B
B
J22
Junction B
B–W
Connector
Ignition Switch
1
2
4
B–Y
I10
I10
1K
B+
6 NSW
E7
GAUGE
1
1J
B–R
1 F14 2 F14
ALT
1 F9 1 F11
B–G
FL
B
MAIN
Battery
Instrument Panel J/B
Instrument Panel J/B
7
5
W–R
I10
1K
5
1B
8
I10
AM2
1
2A
STARTER
3
1J
Engine Room J/B No.2
B
3
2B
Engine Room J/B No.2
J7 J8 Junction Connector
C
B
10
GR
J7
J6
IG2
4
1K
Instrument Panel J/B
W–R Instrument Panel J/B
4
2L
R
11
2J
ST Relay
MAIN 5
3
1
2
5
2D
9
2K
Starter
J9 Junction Connector
A
GR
IF
D06504
DI–167
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Read PNP, REVERSE, 2ND and LOW signals.
When using hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the DLC3 cover.
(b) Connect a hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to ON and hand–held tester main
switch ON.
CHECK:
Shift the shift lever into the P, R, N, 2 and L positions, and read
the PNP, REVERSE, 2ND and LOW signals on the hand–held
tester.
OK:
L NSW
(–)
(+)
2
R
D06387
Shift position
Signal
2
2ND OFF → ON
L
LOW OFF → ON
R
REVERSE OFF → ON
P, N
PNP OFF → ON
When not using hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals NSW, 2, L and R of ECM
and body ground when the shift lever is shifted in the following
positions.
OK:
Position
NSW–Body
ground
R–Body
ground
2–Body
ground
L–Body
ground
P, N
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
R
9 – 14 V*
D
9 – 14 V
0V
2
9 – 14 V
0V
L
9 – 14 V
0V
9 – 14 V*
9 – 14 V
0V
0V
9 – 14 V
HINT:
The voltage will drop slightly due to lighting up of the back up
light.
OK
NG
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page DI–148).
DI–168
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Check park/neutral position switch.
PREPARATION:
(a) Jack up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the park/neutral position switch.
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal shown below when the
shift lever is moved to each position.
Shift Position
Terminal No. to continuity
Terminal No. to continuity
P
4–7
5–6
R
4–8
–
N
4 – 10
5–6
D
4–9
–
2
2–4
–
L
2–3
–
Q07657
OK:
Continuity exists.
NG
Replace the park/neutral position switch.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between battery and park/neutral position switch,
park/neutral position switch and ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Repair or replace the harness and connector.
DI–169
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI038–05
O/D Cancel Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
While driving uphill with cruise control activated, in order to minimize gear shifting and provide smooth cruising overdrive may be prohibited temporarily under some conditions.
The cruise control ECU sends O/D cut signals to the ECM as necessary and the ECM cancels overdrive
shifting until these signals are discontinued.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
ECM
B+
OD
14
C16
Y–B
20
OD1
E4
Q05352
DI–170
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal OD1 of ECM and body ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal OD1 of ECM and body
ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
ON
(–)
(+)
OD1
BE3840
D05153
D05153
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
matrix chart (See page DI–148).
NG
2
Check voltage between terminal OD of cruise control ECU harness side connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the cruise control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal OD of cruise control ECU
harness side connector and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 9 – 14 V
ON
(–)
(+)
OD
BE3840
I00143
D00057
OK
Check and replace the cruise control ECU.
NG
3
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and ECM.
NG
OK
Check and replace the ECM.
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
DI–171
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
DI1J1–04
O/D Main Switch & O/D OFF Indictor Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The O/D main switch contacts go open when the switch is pushed in and go closed when it is pushed out.
In O/D main switch in OFF position, the O/D OFF indicator light lights up, and the ECM prohibits shifting overdrive.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Ignition Switch
2
I10
W
ECM
4
I10
AM1
IG1
G–O
Instrument
Panel J/B
AM1
Instrument Panel
J/B
2
1D
IB 1
GAUGE
C
7
OD2
E4
C
J5
Junction
Connector
C
1
1K
B+
G–O
11 IF1
IK 2
G–O
B–R
2 O2
B–R
1 F14
G–O
R–L
2 F14
ALT
(*)
O/D OFF
J3
Indicator Light
Junction
(Combination Meter)
Connector
7
12
R–L
C12
C10
D
D
FUSIBLE
LINK
BLOCK
1 F9
O/D Main
Switch
4 O2
W–B
A
J4
Junction
Connector
A
W–B
Battery
B–G
IE
FL
MAIN
*: O/D Main Switch
Contacts go open with switch pushed in
contacts go closed with switch pushed once again
D05150
DI–172
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
O/D OFF indicator light does not light up
1
Check O/D main switch.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the O/D main switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity at each terminal 2 and 4 of O/D main switch
connector.
OK:
2
4
Q07595
NG
O/D main switch
Specified condition
ON
No continuity
OFF
Continuity
Replace the O/D main switch.
OK
2
Check and replace combination meter (See page BE–4).
NG
OK
Replace the combination meter.
DI–173
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Check OVERDRIVE CUT SW2 signal.
When using hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the DLC3 cover.
(b) Connect hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the ignition switch to ON and hand–held tester main
switch ON.
CHECK:
Read the OVRDRIVE CUT SW2 signal on the hand–held tester.
OK:
O/D main switch condition
OVRDRIVE CUT SW2 signal
O/D ON (Pushed in)
OFF
O/D OFF (Pushed once again)
ON
When not using hand–held tester:
PREPARATION:
Turn the ignition switch to ON.
CHECK:
Check voltage between terminal OD2 of ECM and body ground.
OK:
ON
OD2
BE3840
D05151
D06388
O/D main switch condition
Voltage
O/D ON (Pushed in)
9 – 14
O/D OFF (Pushed once again)
Below 1.5 V
OK
Check and replace the ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
4
Check harness and connector between O/D OFF indicator light and ECM (See
page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace the ECM (See page
IN–29).
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
DI–174
DIAGNOSTICS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
O/D OFF indicator light remains ON
1
Check O/D main switch.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the O/D main switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity at each terminal 2 and 4 of O/D main switch
connector.
OK:
2
4
Q07595
NG
O/D main switch
Specified condition
ON
No continuity
OFF
Continuity
Replace the O/D main switch.
OK
2
Check harness and connector between O/D OFF indicator light and O/D main
switch, O/D OFF indicator light and ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace the ECM (See page
IN–29).
Repair or replace the harness or connector.
DI–175
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03A–03
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following pages.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
Items inside
are titles of pages in this manual,
with the page number in the bottom portion. See
the pages for detailed explanations.
1
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–176
2
Check and Clear DTC (Precheck)
P. DI–177
Symptom
does not occur
3
Problem Symptom Confirmation
4
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–19
7
Problem Symptoms Table
P. DI–185
Symptom
occurs
5
Normal code
DTC Check
P. DI–177
Malfunction code
6
8
DTC Chart
P. DI–181
Circuit Inspection
9
Sensor Check
Check for Fluid Leakage
P. DI–220
P. DI–186 – DI–218
Identification of Problem
10
11
Repair
Confirmation Test
End
Step 2, 5, 8, 9, 11: Diagnostic steps permitting the use of the
TOYOTA hand–held tester or TOYOTA
break–out–box.
Author:
Date:
245
DI–176
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03B–02
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ABS Check Sheet
Inspector’s
:
Name
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought In
/
Date Problem First Occurred
/
Frequency Problem Occurs
km
miles
Odometer Reading
/
Continuous
/
Intermittent (
times a day)
ABS does not operate.
Symptoms
ABS does not operate efficiently.
ABS Warning Light
Abnormal
Remains ON
Does not Light Up
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
DTC Check
DI–177
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03C–04
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
F00047
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Check the indicator.
When the ignition switch is turned ON, check that the ABS
warning light goes on for 3 seconds.
HINT:
If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to troubleshooting for the ABS warning light circuit (See page DI–213).
(b)
Short Pin
Check the DTC.
(1) Disconnect the short pin from DLC1.
DLC1
F00006
DLC2
Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(3) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(4) Read the DTC from the ABS warning light on the
combination meter.
(2)
DLC1
E1
Tc
Tc
S−17−1
HINT:
E1
Iei−23−1−A
F00041
As an example, the blinking patterns for normal code and
codes 11 and 21 are shown on the left.
(5) Codes are explained in the code table on page
DI–181.
(6) After completing the check, disconnect terminals Tc
and E1, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time the lowest numbered DTC will be displayed 1st.
Normal Code
2 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 11 and 21
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
4 sec.
0.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 11
If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit or ABS
warning light circuit (See page DI–216 or DI–213).
Code 21
R01346
DI–178
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
(c)
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester, check the DTC.
(1) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC2.
(2) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(d)
Clear the DTC.
(1) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1 and remove the short pin from DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Clear the DTC stored in ECU by depressing the
brake pedal 8 or more times within 5 seconds.
DLC2
H07517
BR3890
(4)
Check that the warning light shows the normal
code.
(5) Remove the SST from the terminals of DLC2 or
DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(6) Connect the short pin to DLC1.
Short Pin
DLC1
F00006
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
ECU
TOYOTA
Break–out–box
N09348
(e)
Using TOYOTA break–out–box and TOYOTA hand–held
tester, measure the ECU terminal values.
(1) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester and
TOYOTA break–out–box to the vehicle.
(2) Read the ECU input/output values by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” function. This records the measured values and is effective in the diagnosis of
intermittent problems.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester/TOYOTA break–
out–box operator’s manual for further details.
DI–179
DIAGNOSTICS
2.
(a)
DLC1
E1
–
SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
Check the speed sensor signal.
(1) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(3) Start the engine.
Tc
Ts
F02201
(4)
0.13 sec.
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
BR3904
Check that the ABS warning light blinks.
HINT:
If the ABS warning light does not blink, inspect the ABS warning
light circuit (See page DI–213).
(5) Drive vehicle straight forward.
HINT:
Drive vehicle faster than 45 km/h (28 mph) for several seconds.
(6) Stop the vehicle.
(7) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843 – 18020
(8) Read the number of blinks of the ABS warning light.
HINT:
See the list of DTC shown on the next page.
If every sensor is normal, a normal code is output (A cycle
of 0.25 sec. ON and 0.25 sec. OFF is repeated).
If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the same time,
the lowest numbered code will be displayed 1st.
Malfunction Code (Example Code 72, 76)
7
2
7
6
ON
OFF
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
Repeat
BR3893
(9)
After doing the check, disconnect the SST from terminals Ts and E1, Tc and E1 of DLC1, and turn ignition switch OFF.
SST 09843 – 18020
DI–180
DIAGNOSTICS
TOYOTA
Hand–held Tester
(b)
DLC2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester, check the DTC.
(1) Do step 1. – 6. on the previous page.
(2) Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the
DLC2.
(3) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the tester screen.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
H07517
DTC of speed sensor check function:
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
71
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Right front speed sensor rotor
72
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Left front speed sensor rotor
73
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Right rear speed sensor rotor
74
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Left rear speed sensor rotor
75
Abnormal change in output voltage of right front speed sensor
Right front speed sensor rotor
76
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front speed
sensor
Left front speed sensor rotor
77
Abnormal change in output voltage of right rear speed
sensor
Right rear speed sensor rotor
78
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor rotor
DI–181
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03D–04
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Using SST 09843 –18020, connect the terminals Tc and E1, and remove the short pin.
If any abnormality is not found when inspection parts, inspect the ECU.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for the code. For details
of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ”See page” for respective ”DTC No.” in the DTC
chart.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
11
(DI–186)
Open circuit in ABS solenoid relay circuit
12
(DI–186)
Short circuit in ABS solenoid relay circuit
13
(DI–191)
Open circuit in ABS motor relay circuit
14
(DI–191)
Short circuit in ABS motor relay circuit
21
(DI–195)
Open or short circuit in 2–position solenoid circuit for right front
wheel
ABS actuator
SFRR or SFRH circuit
22
(DI–195)
Open or short circuit in 2–position solenoid circuit for left front
wheel
ABS actuator
SFLR or SFLH circuit
23
(DI–195)
Open or short circuit in 2–position solenoid circuit for right rear
wheel
ABS actuator
SRRR or SRRH circuit
24
(DI–195)
Open or short circuit in 2–position solenoid circuit for left rear
wheel
ABS actuator
SRLR or SRLH circuit
31
(DI–198)
Right front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
32
(DI–198)
Left front wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
33
(DI–198)
Right rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
ABS solenoid relay
ABS solenoid relay circuit
ABS motor relay
ABS motor relay circuit
Right front, left front, right rear and left rear speed sensor
Each
E h speed
d sensor circuit
i it
Speed sensor rotor
34
(DI–198)
Left rear wheel speed sensor signal malfunction
33, 34
(DI–203)
Rear speed sensor rotor faulty
Rear axle hub
Right rear, left rear speed sensor
Rear speed sensor circuit
41
(DI–204)
Power source voltage down
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
49
(DI–207)
Open circuit in stop light switch circuit
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
51
(DI–209)
Pump motor is locked
ABS pump motor
Malfunction in ECU
ECU
Battery
Always ON
(DI–211)
DI–182
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03E–04
PARTS LOCATION
Sensor Rotor
ABS Warning Light
ABS ECU
DLC 1
Front Speed Sensor
ABS Actuator
DLC 2
ABS Solenoid
Relay
ABS Motor Relay
Rear Speed Sensor
Front Speed
Sensor
Stop Light Switch
Sensor Rotor
F01172
DI–183
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI1JL–03
TERMINALS OF ECU
A13
A14
3
2
1
13 12 11 10 9 8 7
12 11 10 9
8
7
26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14
6
5
4
6 5 4 3
2 1
F07155
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
IG1 (A14 – 13) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
B–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
10 – 14
R+ (A14 – 26) – SR (A13 – 7)
GR–R ↔ GR
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
9 – 14
R+ (A14 – 26) – MR (A13 – 1)
GR–R ↔ GR–L
SFRR (A14 – 1) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
W–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFRH (A14 – 2) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
R–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFLR (A13 – 6) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
W–L ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SFLH (A13 – 5) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
L–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRRR (A13 – 12) – GND (A14
– 12, 25)
R–G ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRRH (A13 – 11) – GND (A14
– 12, 25)
W–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRLR (A14 – 14) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
LG–B ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
SRLH (A14 – 15) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
G–Y ↔ W–B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
WA (A14 – 11) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
G B ↔ W–B
G–B
W B
IG switch ON, ABS warning light ON
Below 2.0
IG switch ON
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
STD Voltage (V)
Below 1.0
10 – 14
Stop light switch OFF
Below 1.5
Stop light switch ON
8 – 14
IG switch ON, ABS warning light OFF
10 – 14
STP (A14 – 5) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
G W ↔ W–B
G–W
W B
D/G (A14 – 24) – GND (A14 –
12, 25)
R–L ↔ W–B
Tc (A14 – 8) – GND (A14 – 12,
25)
LG–R ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
8 – 14
Ts (A14 – 21) – GND (A14 – 12,
25)
R–Y ↔ W–B
IG switch ON
8 – 14
FR+ (A13 – 3) – FR– (A13 – 9)
W↔B
IG switch ON, slowly turn right front wheel
AC generation
FL+ (A13 – 8) – FL– (A13 – 2)
R↔G
IG switch ON, slowly turn left front wheel
AC generation
RR+ (A14 – 10) – RR– (A14 –
23)
W↔B
IG switch ON, slowly turn right rear wheel
AC generation
DI–184
DIAGNOSTICS
RL+ (A14 – 22) – RL– (A14 – 9)
R↔G
MT (A13 – 10) – GND (A13 –
12, 25)
R–W ↔ W–B
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
IG switch ON, slowly turn left rear wheel
IG switch ON
AC generation
Below 1.5
DI–185
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03G–05
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
If a normal code is displayed during the DTC check but the problem still occurs, check the circuits for each
problem symptom in the order given in the table below and proceed to the relevant troubleshooting page.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
ABS does not operate
Only when 1. to 4. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
2. Check the DTC reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
3. IG power source circuit.
4. Speed sensor circuit.
5. Check the ABS actuator with a checker.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
(See page *DI–536).
ABS does not operate efficiently
Only when 1. to 4. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
1. Check the DTC reconfirming that the normal code is
output.
2. Speed sensor circuit
3. Stop light switch circuit
4. Check the ABS actuator with a checker.
If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage
(See page *DI–536).
ABS warning light abnormal
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. ABS ECU
DI–213
DI–211
DTC check cannot be done
Only when 1. and 2. are all normal and the problem is still
occurring, replace the ABS ECU.
1. ABS warning light circuit
2. Tc terminal circuit
DI–213
DI–216
Speed sensor signal check cannot be done
1. Ts terminal circuit
2. ABS ECU
DI–218
DI–211
*See Pub. No. RM654U
DI–177
DI–204
DI–198
*BR–50
DI–177
DI–198
DI–207
*BR–50
DI–186
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03H–04
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
11, 12
ABS Solenoid Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This relay supplies power to each ABS solenoid. After the ignition switch is turned ON, if the initial check is
OK, the relay goes on.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
11
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.2 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
when the solenoid relay is ON.*1
2. With solenoid relay ON driving, when IG1 terminal of
ABS ECU is less than 9.5 V.*1
12
Immediately after IG switch has been turned ON, when the
solenoid relay is OFF.*2
Trouble Area
ABS solenoid relay
ABS solenoid relay circuit
ECU
*1 Solenoid relay contact OFF condition:
All of solenoid terminal voltage is half of IG1 terminal voltage or less than.
*2 Solenoid relay contact ON condition:
All of solenoid terminal voltage is half of IG 1 terminal voltage or more.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the ABS solenoid relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and
prohibits ABS control.
DI–187
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
IJ1
GR–R
ABS Solenoid Relay
3
6
4
ABS ECU
26
A14 R+
GR–R
Engine Room
R/B No.3
GR
3
7
A13 SR
DLC1
ABS
Actuator
5
3
3
1
3
2
3
ABS
1
2
3
W–L
B–G
Fusible Link Block
1
F9
1
F10
ALT
B–G
FL Main
W–B
4
A4
1
A5
R–B
11
IJ2
R–B
2
A14 SFRH
5
A5
W–R
12
IJ2
W–R
1
A14 SFRR
3
A5
L–B
5
A13 SFLH
7
A5
W–L
6
A13 SFLR
4
A5
W–R
11
A13 SRRH
8
A5
R–G
12
A13 SRRR
2
A5
G–Y
13
IJ2
G–Y
15
A14 SRLH
6
A5
LG–B
5
IJ2
LG–B
14
A14 SRLR
Battery
EA
F07147
DI–188
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of Engine Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS solenoid relay).
(+)
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS solenoid relay from Engine Room R/B No. 3.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of Engine
Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS solenoid relay).
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
(–)
Engine Room
R/B No. 3
123
45 6
F00048
NG
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
2
Check continuity between terminal 3 of ABS solenoid relay and terminal SRLR,
SRLH, SRRR, SRRH, SFLR, SFLH, SFRR or SFRH of ABS ECU.
ABS
Solenoid
Relay
3
A4
4
A5
ABS
Actuator
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal 3 of Engine Room R/B No.3
(for ABS solenoid relay) and terminal SRLR, SRLH, SRRR,
SRRH, SFLR, SRLH, SFRR or SFRH of ABS ECU.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
Resistance of each solenoid coil
SRLR, SRRR, SFLR, SFRR: 4.3 Ω
SRLH, SRRH, SFLH, SFRH: 8.8 Ω
1234
5678
4321
8765
A13
ECU
SFRH
SFRR
SFLH
SFLR
SRLR
SRLH
SRRH
SRRR
F07153
NG
OK
Repair or replace harness or ABS actuator.
DI–189
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check ABS solenoid relay.
3
2
6
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS solenoid relay.
OK:
1
5
4
Terminals 4 and 6
Continuity (Reference value 80 Ω)
Terminals 2 and 3
Continuity
Terminals 1 and 3
Open
Open
3 2 1
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 4 and 6.
(b) Check continuity between each terminal of ABS solenoid
relay.
OK:
Continuity
Continuity
6 5 4
Terminals 2 and 3
Open
Terminals 1 and 3
Continuity
Continuity
3 2
1
Open
(–)
(+)
6
5 4
F00042
NG
OK
Replace ABS solenoid relay.
DI–190
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS solenoid relay and ABS ECU (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
DI–191
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03I–04
DTC
13, 14
ABS Motor Relay Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ABS motor relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor. While the ABS is activated, the ECU switches
the ABS motor relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
13
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.2 sec. or more:
1. ABS ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V to 18.5 V, and
when motor relay is ON in the midst of initial check or in
operation of ABS control.*1
2. Motor relay is ON driving in the midst of initial check or
in operation of ABS control, ABS ECU terminal IG1 voltage becomes 9.5 V or less.*2
14
Condition below continues for 4 sec. or more:
When the motor relay is OFF, there is open circuit in MT
terminal of ABS ECU.
Trouble Area
ABS motor relay
ABS motor relay circuit
ECU
*1 Relay contact OFF condition: MT terminal voltage is below 3.6 V.
*2 Relay contact ON condition: MT terminal voltage is 3.6 V or above.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the ABS motor relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
DI–192
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B No.3
ABS Motor
Relay
ABS
B–G
1
3
1
F10 1
ABS ECU
3
3
GR–R
1
IJ1
GR–R
26
A14 R+
2
2
3
4
GR–L
3
1
A13 MR
Fusible
Link
Block
ALT
F9 1
ABS Actuator
3
A4
B–G
R–W
10
A13 MT
2
A4
W–R
FL
Main
1
A4
W–B
Battery
EA
F07146
DI–193
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal 1 of Engine Room R/B No. 3 (for ABS motor
relay) and body ground.
(–)
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS motor relay from Engine Room R/B No. 3.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal 1 of Engine Room R/B No.
3 (for ABS motor relay) and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
(+)
1
Engine Room
R/B No. 3
2
3 4
F00049
NG
Check and repair harness or connector.
OK
2
Check continuity between terminal 2 of ABS motor relay and terminal MT of ABS
ECU.
2
ABS
Motor
Relay
2
A4
2
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminal 2 of Engine Room R/B No.3
(for ABS motor relay) and terminal MT of ABS ECU.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
There is a resistance of 4 – 6 Ω between terminals A4 – 2 and
A4 – 3 of ABS actuator.
A4
ABS
Actuator
3
3
A18
ECU
MT
OK
F07154
NG
Repair or replace harness or ABS actuator.
DI–194
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check ABS motor relay.
2
1
4
3
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS motor relay.
OK:
Terminals 3 and 4
Continuity (Reference value 62 Ω)
Terminals 1 and 2
Open
Open
2
Continuity
1
4
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 3 and 4.
(b) Check continuity between terminals of ABS motor relay.
3
Continuity
2
OK:
1
Terminals 1 and 2
(–)
4
Continuity
3
(+)
F00044
NG
Replace ABS motor relay.
OK
4
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS motor
relay and ABS ECU (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
DI–195
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03J–04
DTC
21, 22, 23, 24
ABS Actuator Solenoid Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This solenoid goes on when signals are received from the ECU and controls the pressure acting on the wheel
cylinders thus controlling the braking force.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
21
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.05 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, there
is open or short circuit in actuator solenoid SFRR or
SFRH.
2. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
while ABS is control in operation.*1
ABS actuator
SFRR or SFRH circuit
22
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.05 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, there
is open or short circuit in actuator solenoid SFLR or
SFLH.
2. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
while ABS is control in operation.*1
ABS actuator
SFLR or SFLH circuit
23
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.05 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, there
is open or short circuit in actuator solenoid SRRR or
SRRH.
2. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
while ABS is control in operation.*1
ABS actuator
SRRR or SRRH circuit
24
Condition 1. or 2. continues for 0.05 sec. or more:
1. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, there
is open or short circuit in actuator solenoid SRLR or
SRLH.
2. IG1 terminal voltage of ABS ECU is 9.5 – 18.5 V, and
while ABS is control in operation.*1
ABS actuator
SRLR or SRLH circuit
*1 Solenoid relay contact ON condition:
All of solenoid terminal voltage is half of IG1 terminal voltage or less than.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the actuator solenoid circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits ABS control.
DI–196
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
IJ1
GR–R
ABS Solenoid Relay
3
6
4
ABS ECU
26
A14 R+
GR–R
Engine Room
R/B No.3
GR
3
7
A13 SR
DLC1
ABS
Actuator
5
3
3
1
3
2
3
ABS
1
2
3
W–L
B–G
Fusible Link Block
1
F9
1
F10
ALT
B–G
FL Main
W–B
4
A4
1
A5
R–B
11
IJ2
R–B
2
A14 SFRH
5
A5
W–R
12
IJ2
W–R
1
A14 SFRR
3
A5
L–B
5
A13 SFLH
7
A5
W–L
6
A13 SFLR
4
A5
W–R
11
A13 SRRH
8
A5
R–G
12
A13 SRRR
2
A5
G–Y
13
IJ2
G–Y
15
A14 SRLH
6
A5
LG–B
5
IJ2
LG–B
14
A14 SRLR
Battery
EA
F07147
DI–197
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ABS actuator solenoid.
4
3
8
7
A4
2
1
A5
6
5
4
W00714
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the 2 connectors from ABS actuator.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals A4 – 4 and A5 – 1, 2, 3, 4,
5, 6, 7, 8 of ABS actuator connector.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
Resistance of each solenoid coil is 1.2 Ω.
NG
Replace ABS actuator.
OK
2
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and actuator (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
If the same code is still output after the DTC is deleted, check the contact condition of each connection.
If the connections are normal, the ECU may be defective.
DI–198
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI1JM–03
DTC
Speed Sensor Circuit
31, 32, 33, 34
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Rotor
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are used to control
the ABS system. The front and rear rotors each have 48 serrations.
When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor generates an AC voltage.
Since the frequency of this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU
to detect the speed of each wheel.
Speed Sensor
S Magnet
N
Coil
To ECU
Low Speed
High Speed
+V
BR3583
BR3582
–V
F00010
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
31, 32, 33, 34
Detection of any of conditions from 1. through 4.:
1. Vehicle speed is at 10 km/h (6 mph) or more and the
speed sensor signal circuit is open or short circuit continues for 15 sec. or more.
2. Momentary interruption of the speed sensor signal occurs 7 times or more.
3. Vehicle speed is at 20 km/h (12mph) or more and interference on the speed sensor signal continues for 5 sec.
or more.
4. Open circuit condition of the speed sensor signal circuit
continues for 0.5 sec. or more.
Trouble Area
Right front, left front, right rear, left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Speed sensor rotor
HINT:
DTC No. 31 is for the right front speed sensor.
DTC No. 32 is for the left front speed sensor.
DTC No. 33 is for the right rear speed sensor.
DTC No. 34 is for the left rear speed sensor.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits
ABS control.
DI–199
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS ECU
W
3
A13 FR+
B
9
A13 FR–
2
Right Front
Speed Sensor
1
R
1
IJ2
R
8
A13 FL+
G
6
IJ2
G
2
A13 FL–
W
2
IK1
W
10
A14 RR+
B
1
IK1
B
23
A14 RR–
R
3
IB1
R
22
A14 RL+
G
9
IB1
G
9
A14 RL–
2
Left Front
Speed Sensor
1
1
Right Rear
Speed Sensor
2
1
Left Rear
Speed Sensor
2
F00116
DI–200
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check speed sensor.
1
2
F08572
1
2
F08573
Front:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the front fender liner.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector.
OK:
Resistance: 0.6 – 2.5 kΩ
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
Rear:
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the seat cushion and side seatback.
(b) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector.
OK:
Resistance: 1.2 – 2.3 kΩ
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of speed sensor
connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
NG
Replace speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–177).
OK
DI–201
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between each speed
sensor and ECU (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check speed sensor installation.
CHECK:
Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there is
no clearance between the sensor and steering
knuckle or rear axle carrier.
OK
NG
NG
Replace speed sensor.
BR3795
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–177).
OK
4
Check speed sensor and sensor rotor serrations.
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
2 m/s / Division
1 V / Division
REFERENCE: INSPECTION USING OSCILLOSCOPE
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ABS ECU.
(b) Connect the oscilloscope to the terminals FR+, FL+, RR+
or RL+ and GND of the ABS ECU.
CHECK:
Drive the vehicle with about 30 km/h (19 mph), and check the
signal waveform.
W04200
OK
NG
Check and replace ABS ECU.
DI–202
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check sensor rotor and sensor tip.
R00948
R00947
Front:
PREPARATION:
Remove the front drive shaft (See page SA–6).
CHECK:
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches or missing teeth or foreign objects.
PREPARATION:
Remove the front speed sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U on
page BR–68).
CHECK:
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign objects on the sensor tip.
Rear:
PREPARATION:
Remove the axle hub (See Pub. No. RM654U on page SA–52).
CHECK:
Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches or missing teeth or foreign objects.
PREPARATION:
Remove the rear speed sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U on
page BR–68).
CHECK:
Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign objects on the sensor tip.
NG
Replace sensor rotor or speed sensor.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal last (See page DI–177).
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
DI–203
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03L–04
DTC
33, 34
Rear Speed Sensor Rotor Faulty
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
33, 34
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
The condition that the both rear side wheels’ speed is
lower than the front wheels’ speed at 20 km/h (12 mph) or
more for 20 sec. or more when the IG switch turns ON
and OFF , which is repeated in a sequence more than 8
times.
Rear axle hub
Right rear, left rear speed sensor
Rear speed sensor circuit
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check rear axle hub (See Pub. No. RM654U on page SA–52).
NG
Replace rear axle hub.
OK
2
Check rear speed sensor (See page DI–198).
NG
Replace rear speed sensor.
OK
3
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between rear speed
sensor and ECU (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Repair or replace harness and connector.
DI–204
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03M–04
DTC
41
IG Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the ECU, hence the actuators.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
41
Condition 1. or 2. is detected:
1. Vehicle speed is at 3 km/h (1.9 mph) or more and ECU
terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V or less , which continues
for 10 sec. or more.
2. When IG1 terminal voltage is less than 9.5 V, there is
open circuit in the motor relay or in the solenoid relay, or
the solenoid circuit malfunction.
Trouble Area
Battery
Charging system
Power source circuit
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits
ABS control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Ignition
Switch
B–Y
2
AM1 IG1
4
1
1K
9
1J
ABS ECU
J/C
J12
Instrument Panel J/B
B–R
B–R
C
ECU–IG
C
13
A14 IG1
W
2
1K
Instrument Panel J/B
1
1B
AM1
1
F9
B–G
FL Block
B–R
1
F14
W–B
12
A14 GND1
W–B
25
A14 GND2
ALT
A
FL MAIN
Battery
IF
J9
Junction
Connector
Instrument
Panel Brace LH
F07156
DI–205
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ECU–IG fuse.
PREPARATION:
Remove ECU–IG fuse from Instrument Panel J/B.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
OK:
Continuity
ECU–IG
Instrument
Panel J/B
NG
Check for short circuit in all the harness and
components connected to ECU–IG fuse (See attached wiring diagram).
NG
Check and repair the charging system (See Pub.
No. RM654U on page CH–1).
F00073
OK
2
Check battery positive voltage.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
OK
DI–206
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS ECU with connectors still connected.
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals IG1 and GND of ABS
ECU connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
(–)
(+)
IG1
GND
GND
F07151
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
4
Check continuity between terminals GND of ABS ECU connector and body
ground.
LOCK
F07152
GND (+)
(–)
GND
F07216
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector from the ABS ECU.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal GND of ABS ECU connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 Ω or less
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU and ECU–IG fuse (See page
IN–29).
DI–207
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03N–04
DTC
49
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
49
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
ABS ECU terminal IG1 voltage is 9.5 V to 18.5 V and ABS
is in non–operation, the open circuit of the stop light switch
circuit continues for 0.3 sec. or more.
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS ECU
J/C
G–W
Instrument
Panel J/B
Stop Light
1R 5
Switch
4
2
G–W
1R
1S
2
1
W
J23
A
J24
C
G–W
7
R
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1C
1
F9
STOP
FL Block
Light Failure
Sensor
1
4
1B
1
B–R
F14
ALT
B–G
MAIN
G–W
5
A14 STP
G–R 2
G–R
G–R
2 R10
2 R8
H8 2
High
Right
Mounted
Stop
Stop
Light
5 R10
5 R8
H8 1
Light
W–B
W–B A
W–B
W–B
J/C
W–B
A
J34
W–B
Battery
BK Under the
Left Center
Pillar
BM
Left
Stop
Light
Back Panel
Center
F00124
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of stop light.
CHECK:
Check that stop light lights up when brake pedal is depressed and turns off when brake pedal is released.
NG
OK
Repair stop light circuit (See Pub. No. RM654U
on page BE–37).
DI–208
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal STP of ABS ECU and body ground.
STP
(+)
(–)
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS ECU with connectors still connected.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal STP of ABS ECU and body
ground when brake pedal is depressed.
OK:
Voltage: 8 – 14 V
F07150
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
3
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU and stop
light switch (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on problem symptoms table (See page DI–185).
DI–209
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI4KW–02
DTC
51
ABS Pump Motor Lock
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
51
Trouble Area
ABS pump motor
ABS actuator pump motor is not operating normally.
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the ABS pump motor, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits
ABS control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B No.3
ABS Motor
Relay
ABS
B–G
1
3
1
F10 1
ABS ECU
3
3
GR–R
1
IJ1
GR–R
26
A14 R+
2
2
3
4
GR–L
3
1
A13 MR
Fusible
Link
Block
ALT
F9 1
ABS Actuator
3
A4
B–G
R–W
10
A13 MT
2
A4
W–R
FL
Main
1
A4
W–B
Battery
EA
F07146
DI–210
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of ABS & TRAC pump motor.
A4
1
2
(–)
(+)
F03291
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the ABS actuator connector.
CHECK:
Connect positive lead to terminal A4–2 and negative lead
to terminal A4 – 1 of the ABS actuator connector, check that the
pump motor is operates.
OK:
The running sound of the pump motor should be
heard.
OK
NG
Replace ABS actuator.
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between ABS motor relay, ABS actuator and
ABS ECU (See page IN–29).
DI–211
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03P–05
DTC
Always ON
ABS ECU Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
Always ON
DTC Detecting Condition
ABS ECU internal malfunction is detected.
Trouble Area
ECU
Battery
Fail safe function:
If trouble occurs in the power source circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS solenoid relay and prohibits
ABS control.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Is DTC output?
Check DTC on page DI–177.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
YES
Check ABS solenoid relay. Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS solenoid relay and DLC1 (See page IN–29).
YES
Check for open or short circuit in harness and
connector between ECU–IG fuse and ABS ECU
(See page IN–29).
NO
2
Is normal code displayed?
NO
3
NO
Is ABS warning light go off?
DI–212
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check battery positive voltage.
CHECK:
Check the battery positive voltage.
OK:
10 – 14 V
NG
Check and repair the charging system (See Pub.
No. RM654U on page CH–1).
OK
5
Check ABS warning light.
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the connector from the ABS ECU.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Check the ABS warning light goes off.
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
NG
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS warning light, DLC1, DLC2, and
ABS ECU (See page IN–29).
DI–213
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03Q–04
ABS Warning Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the ECU detects trouble, it lights the ABS warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS control. At
this time, the ECU records a DTC in memory.
After removing the short pin of the DLC1, connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or DLC2 to make the
ABS warning light blink and output the DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room R/B No. 3
Instrument Panel J/B
2
1D
ABS Solenoid Relay
1
Battery
6
2
4
5
GAUGE
R–L
3
D
ABS ECU
J/C
J3
3
3
R–L
8
IJ2
R–L
D
R–L
3
3
4 IG3
C12 7
ABS Warning
R–L
Light
23
C12 4
Short
DLC1
ABS ECU
Pin
R–L
22
12 IF1
G–B
3
W–L
4 A4
ABS
Actuator
W–B
ABS ECU
EA
5 IG3
G–B
G–B
C
C
J/C
J22
G–B 11
A14 WA
C
F07217
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Troubleshooting in accordance with the chart below for each trouble symptom.
ABS warning light does not light up
Go to step 1
ABS warning light remains on
Go to step 3
1
Check ABS warning light.
See combination meter troubleshooting on page See Pub. No. RM654U on page BE–2.
NG
OK
Repair bulb or combination meter assembly.
DI–214
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check ABS solenoid relay.
3
2
1
6
5
4
PREPARATION:
Remove ABS solenoid relay from Engine Room R/B No. 3.
CHECK:
Check continuity between each terminal of ABS solenoid relay.
OK:
Open
3 2 1
Terminals 4 and 6
Continuity (Reference value 80 Ω)
Terminals 2 and 3
Continuity
Terminals 1 and 3
Open
Continuity
Continuity
CHECK:
(a) Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 4 and 6.
(b) Check continuity between each terminal of ABS solenoid
relay.
OK:
65 4
Continuity
3 2 1
Terminals 2 and 3
Open
Terminals 1 and 3
Continuity
Open
(–)
6 5
4
CHECK:
Connect the test lead to terminal 5 and the lead to terminal
3. Check continuity between the terminals.
OK:
Continuity
If there is no continuity, connect the test lead to terminal 5
and the lead to terminal 3. Recheck continuity between terminals.
(+)
Continuity
(–)
3 2 1
(+)
65 4
F00043
NG
Replace ABS solenoid relay.
OK
Check for open circuit in harness and connector between DLC1, ABS solenoid relay and body
ground (See page IN–29).
DI–215
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Is DTC output?
Check DTC on page DI–177.
YES
Repair circuit indicated by the code output.
NO
4
Does ABS warning light go off if short pin is removed?
NO
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between ABS warning light, DLC1 and ABS
ECU (See page IN–29).
YES
5
Check ABS solenoid relay (See step 2).
NG
Replace ABS solenoid relay.
OK
Check for short circuit in harness and connector between DLC1 and ABS solenoid relay (See
page IN–29).
DI–216
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03R–04
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Connecting between terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 or the DLC2 causes the ECU to display the DTC by
flashing the ABS warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
6
IG3
BR
DLC1
A
J20
J/C
B J/C C
J7
J6
BR
BR
A
3
E1
Tc
J/C
J2
DLC2
BR
3
LG–R
11
E1
11
IG3
LG–R
Tc
B
4
ABS ECU
LG–R 8
A14 Tc
B
B
LG–R
A
BR
EC
F00113
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or DLC1.
DLC2
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2 or
DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
DLC1
E1
Tc
E1
Tc
F02607 F00445
F02612
OK
NG
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Tc
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
DI–217
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC2 or DLC1, DLC2 or DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–218
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03S–04
Ts Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The sensor check circuit detects abnormalities in the speed sensor signal which cannot be detected with
the DTC check.
Connecting terminals Ts and E1 of the DLC1 in the engine compartment starts the check.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ABS ECU
DLC1
BR
3
E1
Ts
R–Y
16
8
IG3
R–Y
8
A14 Ts
A
J20
J/C
BR
A
EC
F00172
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
CHECK:
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure voltage between terminals Ts and E1 of DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
E1
Ts
AB0119
S08096
DLC1
F00446
OK
NG
If ABS warning light does not blink even after Ts
and E1 are connected, the ECU may be defective.
DI–219
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
Check for open and short circuit in harness and connector between ABS ECU
and DLC1, DLC1 and body ground (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace ABS ECU.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–220
DIAGNOSTICS
–
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
DI03T–04
Check for Fluid Leakage
Check for fluid leakage from actuator or hydraulic lines.
F00071
DI–221
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1AX–09
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Item inside
are titles of pages in this manual,
with the page number in the bottom portion. See the
pages for detailed explanations.
Customer Problem Analysis
DI–222
2
Warning Light Check
Remains OFF
DI–223
Remains ON
3
4
DTC Check (Read Present DTC)
DTC Check (Read Past DTC)
DI–223
DI–223
5
DTC Chart
DI–229
6
Circuit Inspection
Normal
7
DI–234 to DI–313
Malfunction Code
Symptom Simulation
IN–19
Warning Light
Remains OFF
Warning Light
ON
Identification of Problem
8
Repair
DTC Check
DI–223
9
10
Clear DTC (Present and Past DTC)
DI–223
Warning Light Check
Remains ON
DI–223
Remains OFF
11
DTC Check (Read Past DTC)
DI–223
Confirmation Test
END
Step 3, 4, 6, 8, 9, 11 : Diagnostic steps permitting the use
of the TOYOTA hand–held tester.
Author:
Date:
291
DI–222
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI15Z–09
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
Inspector’s
Name
Supplemental Restraint System Check Sheet
Registration No.
Customer’s Name
Registration Year
/
/
Frame No.
Date Vehicle Brought In
/
/
km
Miles
Odometer Reading
/
Date Problem Occurred
Weather
Fine
Temperature
Cloudy
Rainy
Snowy
/
Other
Approx.
Starting
Vehicle Operation
Driving
Idling
[
Constant speed
Other
Acceleration
Deceleration
]
Road Conditions
Details Of Problem
Vehicle Inspection, Repair History Prior to Occurrence of Malfunction (Including Supplemental Restraint System)
Diagnosis System Inspection
SRS Warning Light
Inspection
1st Time
Remains ON
Sometimes Light Up
Does Not Light Up
2nd Time
Remains ON
Sometimes Light Up
Does Not Light Up
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code
[ Code.
]
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code
[ Code.
]
DTC Inspection
DI–223
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L1–05
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
(b)
SRS WARNING LIGHT CHECK
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position and
check that the SRS warning light lights up.
Check that the SRS warning light goes out after approx.
6 seconds.
HINT:
H10313
2.
(a)
DLC1
E1
Tc
R13006
When the ignition switch is at ACC or ON and the SRS
warning light remains on or flashes, the airbag sensor assembly has detected a malfunction code.
If, after approx. 6 seconds have elapsed, the SRS warning light sometimes lights up or the SRS warning light
lights up even when the ignition switch is OFF, a short in
the SRS warning light circuit can be considered likely.
Proceed to ”SRS warning light circuit malfunction” on
page DI–308.
DTC CHECK (Using diagnosis check wire)
Present troubles codes:
Output the DTC.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position
and wait for approx. 20 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of the
DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
NOTICE:
Pay due attention to the terminal connecting position to
avoid a malfunction.
(b) Past troubles codes:
Output the DTC.
(1) Using service wire, connect Terminals Tc and E1 of
the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(2) Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position
and wait for approx. 20 seconds.
NOTICE:
Pay due attention to the terminal connecting position to
avoid a malfunction.
DI–224
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(c)
Normal Code
0.25
ON
OFF
0.25
Code 11 and 31
0.5
4.0
2.5
ON
OFF
1.5
0.5
DTC 11
AT0716
AB0056
Repeat
DTC 31
H08231
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester
DLC3
S05331
Read the DTC.
Read the 2–digit DTC as indicated by the number of times
the SRS warning light blinks. As an example, the blinking
patterns, normal, 11 and 31 are shown in the illustration.
Normal code indication
The light will blink 2 times per second.
Malfunction code indication
The first blinking output indicates the first digit
of a 2–digit DTC. After a 1.5–second pause,
the second blinking output will indicate the
second digit.
If there are 2 or more codes, there will be a 2.5–second pause
between each code. After all the codes have been output, there
will be a 4.0–second pause and they will all be repeated.
HINT:
In the event of a number of trouble codes, indication will
start from the smallest numbered code.
If a DTC is not output or a DTC is output without terminal
connection, proceed to the Tc terminal circuit inspection
on page DI–313.
3.
(a)
(b)
DTC CHECK (Using TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Read the DTCs by following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
4.
DTC CLEARANCE (Not using service wire)
When the ignition switch is turned off, the diagnostic trouble
code is cleared.
HINT:
DTC might not be cleared by turning the ignition switch OFF.
In this case, proceed to the next step.
5.
DTC CLEARANCE (Using service wire)
(a) Connect the 2 service wires to terminals Tc and AB of
DLC1.
(b) Turn the ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait for approx.
6 seconds.
DI–225
DIAGNOSTICS
(c)
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Starting with the Tc terminal, ground alternately terminal
Tc and terminal AB twice each in cycles of 1.0 seconds.
Make sure that the terminals are grounded. Ensure the
terminal Tc remain grounded.
HINT:
When alternately grounding terminals Tc and AB, release
ground from one terminal and immediately ground the other terminal within an interval of 0.2 seconds.
If DTCs are not cleared, repeat the above procedure until the
codes are cleared.
Terminal
1 seconds
OFF
Tc
Tc
AB
Body
Ground
1 seconds
(± 0.5 sec.)(± 0.5 sec.)
3
1
5
OFF
AB
Body
Ground
2
4
Several
Seconds
ON
50 m sec.
OFF
50 m sec.
H10313
H01461
H10314
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester
(d)
Several seconds after doing the clearing procedure, the
SRS warning light will blink in a 50 m sec. cycle to indicate
the codes which have been cleared.
6.
(a)
(b)
DTC CLEARANCE (Using TOYOTA hand–held tester)
Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Clear the DTCs by following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operation’s
manual for further details.
DLC3
S05331
DI–226
DIAGNOSTICS
7.
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RELEASE METHOD OF AIRBAG ACTIVATION PREVENTION MECHANISM
An airbag activation prevention mechanism is built into the connector for the squib circuit of the SRS.
When release of the airbag activation prevention mechanism is
directed in the troubleshooting procedure as shown in the illustration of the connectors on the next pages, insert paper
which has the same thickness as the male terminal, between
the terminal and the short spring.
CAUTION:
Never release the airbag activation prevention mechanism
on the steering wheel pad connector.
NOTICE:
Do not release the airbag activation prevention mechanism unless specifically directed by the troubleshooting procedure.
If the inserted paper is too thick the terminal and short
spring may be damaged, so always use paper with
the same thickness as the male terminal.
DI–227
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
8
Pretensioner (RH)
9
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
10
4
Front Passenger Airbag
Assembly (Squib)
2
Spiral Cable
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
1
5
7
3
Steering Wheel
Pad (Squib)
6
No.1 J/B
11
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
12
Pretensioner (LH)
H02720
DI–228
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Airbag Sensor Assembly Connector
1
3
Short Spring
Short Spring
2
Short Spring
After Release
Before Release
Paper
Connector 5 6
Connector 4 7
Short Spring
Short Spring
Before Release
After Release
Paper
Paper
H04511
H01356
H01233
AB0130
AB0045
H02249
H02248
AB0046
H11583
DI–229
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1AZ–09
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table
below (Proceed to the page given for that circuit.).
DTC No.
(See Page)
Detection Item
Short in D squib circuit
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Front passenger airbag assembly (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
ON
Seat belt pretensioner RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Seat belt pretensioner RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit
(to Ground)
Seat belt pretensioner RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit
(to B+)
Seat belt pretensioner RH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit
Seat belt pretensioner LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Seat belt pretensioner LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Open in D squib circuit
B0101/14
(DI–239)
Short in D squib circuit (to Ground)
B0102/11
(DI–243)
Short in D squib circuit (to B+)
B0103/12
(DI–247)
B0106/54
(DI–255)
B0107/51
(DI–258)
B0108/52
(DI–261)
B0130/63
(DI–264)
B0131/64
(DI–268)
B0132/61
(DI–271)
B0133/62
(DI–274)
B0135/73
(DI–277)
B0136/74
(DI–281)
SRS
Warning Light
Steering wheel pad (squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
B0100/13
(DI–234)
B0105/53
(DI–251)
Trouble Area
Short in P squib circuit
Open in P squib circuit
Short in P squib circuit (to Ground)
Short in P squib circuit (to B+)
Short in P/T squib (RH) circuit
Open in P/T squib (RH) circuit
Open in P/T squib (LH) circuit
DI–230
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC No.
(See Page)
B0137/71
(DI–284)
B0138/72
(DI–287)
B1100/31
(DI–290)
B1156/B1157/
15
(DI–292)
B1158/B1159/
16
(DI–300)
Normall
N
(DI–305)
Detection Item
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Trouble Area
SRS
Warning Light
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit
(to Ground)
Seat belt pretensioner LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Short in P/T squib (LH) circuit
(to B+)
Seat belt pretensioner LH (squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
Blink
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly
Front airbag sensor (RH) malfunction
Front airbag sensor (RH)
Wire harness
Engine room main wire harness
Airbag sensor assembly
ON
Front airbag sensor (LH)
Wire harness
Airbag sensor assembly
ON
Front airbag sensor (LH) malfunction
System normal
Voltage source drop
ON
–
Battery
Airbag sensor assembly
OFF
ON
HINT:
When the SRS warning light remains lit up and the DTC is the normal code, this means a voltage source
drops.
This malfunction is not stored in memory by the airbag sensor assembly and if the power source voltage returns to normal, the SRS warning light will automatically go out.
When 2 or more codes are indicated, the codes will be displayed in numeral order starting from the
lowest numbered code.
If a code not listed on the chart is displayed, the airbag sensor assembly is faulty.
DI–231
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B0–10
PARTS LOCATION
Steering Wheel Pad
(with Airbag)
Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Combination Meter
(Warning Light)
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (RH)
Spiral Cable
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (LH)
H10307
DI–232
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B1–15
TERMINALS OF ECU
C6
C5
C4
B
6
A
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
25 24 23 22 21 20 19
18
12
11 10
9
8
7
B
6
5
4
3
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12
12
11 10
9
8
7
28 27 26
A
11 10
A
B
H01357
No.
Symbol
A
–
Electrical Connector Check Mechanism
Terminal Name
B
–
Electrical Connector Check Mechanism
C5 – 3
LA
C5 – 4
GSW
C5 – 5
IG2
Power Source (IGN Fuse)
C5 – 6
ACC
Power Source (CIG Fuse)
C5 – 9
SR+
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
C5 – 10
P+
Squib (Passenger)
C5 – 11
P–
Squib (Passenger)
C5 – 12
SIL
Diagnosis
C5 – 13
D–
Squib (Driver)
C5 – 14
D+
Squib (Driver)
C5 – 15
SL+
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
C5 – 19
Tc
C5 – 20
SR–
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
C5 – 26
SL–
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
C5 – 27
E1
Ground
C5 – 28
E2
Ground
C4 – 1
PL–
Squib (Seat Belt Pretensioner, LH)
C4 – 2
PL+
Squib (Seat Belt Pretensioner, LH)
C6 – 5
PR+
Squib (Seat Belt Pretensioner, RH)
C6 – 6
PR–
Squib (Seat Belt Pretensioner, RH)
SRS Warning Light
EFI ECU
Diagnosis
DI–233
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI164–25
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Proceed with troubleshooting of each circuit in the table below.
Symptom
With the ignition switch in ACC or ON position, the SRS warning
light sometimes lights up after approx. 6 seconds have elapsed.
SRS warning light is always lit up even when ignition switch is in
the LOCK position.
With the ignition switch in ACC or ON position, the SRS warning
light does not light up.
Suspect Area
See page
SRS warning light circuit
(Al
(Always
lights
li ht up when
h ignition
i iti switch
it h is
i in
i LOCK posii
tion.)
DI 308
DI–308
SRS warning light circuit
(Does not light up when ignition switch is turned to ACC or
ON.)
DI–308
Tc terminal circuit
DI–313
DTC is not displayed.
SRS warning light is always lit up at the time of DTC check procedure.
DTC is displayed without Tc and E1 terminal connection.
DI–234
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI18Q–15
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
B0100/13
Short in D Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and steering wheel pad.
It causes the airbag to deploy when the airbag deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0100/13 is recorded when a short is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0100/13
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between D+ wire harness and D– wire harness of squib
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Steering wheel pad (D squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
D Squib
1
Y–B
14
C5 D+
2
Y
13
C5 D–
Spiral
Cable
H01451
DI–235
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check D squib circuit.
Spiral
Cable
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
D–
D+
D Squib
(–)
H01001
R14286
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the spiral cable (See page
DI–223).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
H01134
NG
OK
Go to step 5.
DI–236
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
ACC
→←
ON
or
DTC B0100/13
DLC1
E1
H01002
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 FI1390
OK
–
Tc
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0100/13 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0100/13 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
H07478
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–237
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check D squib.
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
ACC
ON
or
DTC B0100/13
DLC1
E1
Tc
H01003
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 FI1390
H01136
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0100/13 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0100/13 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace steering wheel pad.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–238
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
←→
D–
(–)
D+
(+)
H01000
R14286
H01137
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the connector between the airbag sensor assembly and the spiral cable.
(b) Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of
the spiral cable connector on the airbag sensor assembly
side (See page DI–223).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Repair or replace spiral cable.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the spiral cable (See page
DI–223).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the airbag
sensor assembly and the spiral cable, measure the resistance
between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
D–
(–)
D+
(+)
NG
H01004
R14286
H01138
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–239
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI18R–23
DTC
B0101/14
Open in D Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and steering wheel pad.
It causes the airbag to deploy when the airbag deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0101/14 is recorded when an open is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
B0101/14
Trouble Area
Open circuit in D+ wire harness or D– wire harness of
squib
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Steering wheel pad (D squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–234.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check D squib circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
D–
(–)
H01001
R14286
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
D+
(+)
H01139
NG
OK
Go to step 5.
DI–240
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
D–
D+
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01002 AB0069
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 W02044
DTC B0101/14
Tc
H01140
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– of the connector
(on the spiral cable side) between the spiral cable and the
steering wheel pad.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0101/14 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0101/14 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–241
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check D squib.
D Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01003
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 W02044
DTC B0101/14
Tc
H01141
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0101/14 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0101/14 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace steering wheel pad.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–242
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check spiral cable.
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
←→
D–
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
D+
H01000
R14286
H01142
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector between the airbag sensor assembly
and the spiral cable.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
NG
Repair or replace spiral cable.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
D–
(–)
H01004
R14286
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the airbag
sensor assembly and the spiral cable, measure the resistance
between D+ and D–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
D+
(+)
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
H01143
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–243
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L2–05
DTC
B0102/11
Short in D Squib Circuit (to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and steering wheel pad.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0102/11 is recorded when a ground short is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0102/11
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib wire harness (to ground)
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Steering wheel pad (D squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–234.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check D squib circuit.
Spiral
Cable
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the resistance between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
D Squib
D+
H01001
R14301
H01126
NG
OK
Go to step 5.
DI–244
DIAGNOSTICS
3
D Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
D–
D+
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0102/11
Tc
H01002
W01933 AB0069
AB0118 AB0118
R13006 W02042
H01127
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– of the connector
(on the spiral cable side) between the spiral cable and the
steering wheel pad.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0102/11 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0102/11 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Spiral
Cable
E1
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–245
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check D squib.
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01003
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 W02042
DTC B0102/11
Tc
H01128
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0102/11 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0102/11 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace steering wheel pad.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–246
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
←→
D+
(–)
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the connector between the airbag sensor assembly
and the spiral cable.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the steering wheel pad and the spiral cable, measure the resistance between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
H01000
R14301
H01129
NG
Repair or replace spiral cable.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
CHECK:
For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the spiral
cable and airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
D+
(–)
H01004
R14301
(+)
H06304
NG
Repair or replace harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–247
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4L3–05
DTC
B0103/12
Short in D Squib Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The D squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly, spiral cable and steering wheel pad.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0103/12 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the D squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in D squib wire harness (to B+)
D squib malfunction
Spiral cable malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0103/12
Steering wheel pad (D squib)
Spiral cable
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–234.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check D squib circuit.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the
spiral cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the voltage between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
D+
(–)
AB0119
H01001
R14288
(+)
H04530
NG
OK
Go to step 5.
DI–248
DIAGNOSTICS
3
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
D+
D–
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DTC B0103/12
DLC1
Tc
H01002 AB0069
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 W02043
H01131
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect D+ and D– of the connector
(on the spiral cable side) between the spiral cable and the
steering wheel pad.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0103/12 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0103/12 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
E1
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–249
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check D squib.
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
ACC
ON
or
DTC B0103/12
DLC1
E1
–
Tc
H01003
AB0118 AB0019
R13006 W02043
H01132
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0103/12 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0103/12 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace steering wheel pad.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–250
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check spiral cable.
Spiral
Cable
←→
D Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
D+
(–)
(+)
H01000
AB0119
R14288
H01133
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect the connector between the airbag sensor assembly and the spiral cable.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the
spiral cable and the steering wheel pad, measure the voltage between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
NG
Repair or replace spiral cable.
OK
6
Check harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Spiral
Cable
D Squib
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the spiral cable side) between the
spiral cable and airbag sensor assembly, measure the
voltage between D+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
D+
(–)
AB0119
H01004
R14288
(+)
H08261
NG
Repair or replace harness between airbag sensor assembly and spiral cable.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–251
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B6–20
DTC
B0105/53
Short in P Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag assembly.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0105/53 is recorded when a short is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0105/53
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib wire harness
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Front passenger airbag assembly (P squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
P Squib
1
Y–R
10
C5 P+
2
Y–G
11
C5 P–
H01454
DI–252
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P squib circuit.
PREPARATION:
Release airbag activation prevention mechanism of the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front
passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly
(See page DI–223).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front passenger airbag assembly
side) between the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between P+ and
P–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P–
(–)
R14286
H02142
OK
P+
(+)
H02251
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between front passenger airbag assembly and airbag sensor assembly.
DI–253
DIAGNOSTICS
3
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
AB0119
H01077
DTC B0105/53
Tc
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0105/53 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0105/53 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
H07479
NG
OK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P Squib
H01023
AB0118
R13006
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–254
DIAGNOSTICS
4
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P squib.
P Squib
H01024
AB0118
R13006
–
DTC B0105/53
Tc
AB0119
H01077
H01202
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory. (See page DI–223)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC. (See page DI–223)
OK:
DTC B0105/53 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0105/53 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–255
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B7–25
DTC
B0106/54
Open in P Squib Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag assembly.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0106/54 is recorded when an open is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0106/54
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in P+ wire harness or P– wire harness of
squib
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Front passenger airbag assembly (P squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–251.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P squib circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front passenger airbag assembly
side) between the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between P+ and
P–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P–
(–)
R14286
H02142
OK
P+
(+)
NG
H02251
Repair or replace harness or connector between front passenger airbag assembly and airbag sensor assembly.
DI–256
DIAGNOSTICS
3
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
P+
P–
or
DLC1
DTC B0106/54
Tc
H01023
H02144
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01078
H02253
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– of the connector
(on the front passenger airbag assembly side) between
the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0106/54 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0106/54 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P Squib
E1
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–257
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P squib.
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01024
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01078
DTC B0106/54
Tc
H01205
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0106/54 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0106/54 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–258
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B8–17
DTC
B0107/51
Short in P Squib Circuit (to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag assembly.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0107/51 is recorded when a ground short is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0107/51
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib wire harness (to ground)
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Front passenger airbag assembly (P squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–251.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P squib circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front passenger airbag assembly
side) between the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between P+ and
body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P+
(–)
H01227
H02145
OK
(+)
NG
H02254
Repair or replace harness or connector between front passenger airbag assembly and airbag sensor assembly.
DI–259
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
P+
P–
or
DTC B0107/51
DLC1
E1 Tc
H01023 H02144
AB0118 AB0118
R13006 H01075
H02255
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– of the connector
(on the front passenger airbag assembly side) between
the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0107/51 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0107/51 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–260
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P squib.
P Squib
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0107/51
Tc
H01024
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01075
H01196
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0107/51 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0107/51 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–261
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1B9–23
DTC
B0108/52
Short in P Squib Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P squib circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front passenger airbag assembly.
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0108/52 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the P squib circuit.
DTC No.
B0108/52
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P squib wire harness (to B+)
P squib malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Front passenger airbag assembly (P squib)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–251.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P squib circuit.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the front passenger airbag assembly side) between the front passenger airbag assembly
and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between the P+ and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P Squib
P+
(–)
AB0119
H01022
H02146
OK
(+)
NG
H08262
Repair or replace harness or connector between front passenger airbag assembly and airbag sensor assembly.
DI–262
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P Squib
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
P+
P–
or
DTC B0108/52
DLC1
E1
Tc
H01023 H02144
AB0118 AB0118
R13006 H01076
H02257
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect P+ and P– of the connector
(on the front passenger airbag assembly side) between
the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0108/52 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0108/52 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–263
DIAGNOSTICS
4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P squib.
P Squib
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
–
DTC B0108/52
Tc
H01024
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01076
H01199
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0108/52 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0108/52 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace front passenger airbag assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–264
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI16S–25
DTC
B0130/63
Short in P/T Squib (RH) Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0130/63 is recorded when a short is detected in the P/T squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0130/63
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit between PR+ wire harness and PR– wire
harness of squib
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Seat belt pretensioner (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
1
Y–B
5
C6
PR+
2
Y
6
C6
PR–
H01454
DI–265
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P/T squib (RH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
PR+
(+)
H01019
H02141
OK
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the seat belt pretensioner (RH)
(See page DI–223).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between PR+ and PR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
PR–
(–)
NG
H02203
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
DI–266
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0130/63
E1
H01020
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01082
Tc
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0130/63 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0130/63 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
H07485
NG
OK
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–267
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (RH).
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0130/63
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01082
Tc
H01214
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 second.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0130/63 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0130/63 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–268
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BG–20
DTC
B0131/64
Open in P/T Squib (RH) Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib circuit (RH) consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0131/64 is recorded when an open is detected in the P/T squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B0131/64
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in PR+ wire harness or PR– wire harness of
squib
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Seat belt pretensioner (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–264.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P/T squib (RH) circuit.
P/T Squib (RH)
PR+
(+)
H01019
H02141
OK
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between PR+ and PR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
PR–
NG
(–)
H02205
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
DI–269
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
PR+
PR–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01020
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01083
DTC B0131/64
Tc
H02206
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PR+ and PR– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the
seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0131/64 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0131/64 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–270
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (RH).
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01083
DTC B0131/64
Tc
H01217
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0131/64 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0131/64 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–271
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BH–16
DTC
B0132/61
Short in P/T Squib (RH) Circuit
(to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0132/61 is recorded when a ground short is detected in the P/T squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P/T squib (RH) wire harness (to ground)
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0132/61
Seat belt pretensioner (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–264.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P/T squib (RH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between PR+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
PR+
(–)
(+)
NG
H01019
H08392
OK
H08393
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
DI–272
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
PR+
PR–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01020
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01079
DTC B0132/61
Tc
H02208
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PR+ and PR– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the
seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0132/61 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0132/61 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–273
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (RH).
P/T Squib (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01079
DTC B0132/61
Tc
H01208
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0132/61 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0132/61 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–274
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BI–19
DTC
B0133/62
Short in P/T Squib (RH) Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (RH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0133/62 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the P/T squib (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in seat belt pretensioner (RH) wire harness
(to B+)
P/T squib (RH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0133/62
Seat belt pretensioner (RH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–264.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P/T squib (RH) circuit.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between PR+ and
body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
PR+
(–)
(+)
NG
H01019
AB0119
H08394
OK
H08268
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (RH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
DI–275
DIAGNOSTICS
3
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
PR+
PR–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
H01020
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01081
DTC B0133/62
Tc
H02210
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PR+ and PR– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the
seat belt pretensioner (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0133/62 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0133/62 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (RH)
E1
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–276
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (RH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (RH)
→←
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01021
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01081
DTC B0133/62
Tc
H01211
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (RH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0133/62 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0133/62 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (RH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–277
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI16W–25
DTC
B0135/73
Short in P/T Squib (LH) Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0135/73 is recorded when a short is detected in the P/T squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
B0135/73
Short circuit between PL+ wire harness and PL– wire harness of squib
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
Seat belt pretensioner (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
1
2
Y–B
Y
2
C4
PL+
1
C4
PL–
H01454
DI–278
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P/T squib (LH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
PL+
(+)
H01016
H02141
OK
PREPARATION:
Release the airbag activation prevention mechanism of the
connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the
airbag sensor assembly and the seat belt pretensioner (LH)
(See page DI–223).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between PL+ and PL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
PL–
(–)
NG
H02211
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
DI–279
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01017
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01086
DTC B0135/73
Tc
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0135/73 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
H07487
NG
OK
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–280
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (LH).
→←
P/T Squib (LH)
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01086
DTC B0135/73
Tc
H01229
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOOK, and wait at least for 20 second.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Clear DTC stored in memory. (See page DI–223)
(d) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(e) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(f)
Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0135/73 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0135/73 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–281
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BJ–21
DTC
B0136/74
Open in P/T Squib (LH) Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib circuit (LH) consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0136/74 is recorded when an open is detected in the P/T squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Open circuit in PL+ wire harness or PL– wire harness of
squib
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0136/74
Seat belt pretensioner (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–277.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P/T squib (LH) circuit.
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
PL+
(+)
H01016
H02141
OK
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between PL+ and PL–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
PL–
NG
(–)
H02213
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
DI–282
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
PL+
PL–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0136/74
E1
H01017
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01087
Tc
H02214
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PL+ and PL– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat
belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0136/74 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0136/74 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–283
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (LH).
P/T Squib (LH)
→←
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
E1
DTC B0136/74
Tc
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01087
H01232
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0136/74 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0136/74 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–284
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BK–16
DTC
B0137/71
Short in P/T Squib (LH) Circuit
(to Ground)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0137/71 is recorded when a ground short is detected in the P/T squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in P/T squib (LH) wire harness (to ground)
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0137/71
Seat belt pretensioner (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–277.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P/T squib (LH) circuit.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between
the seat belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly,
measure the resistance between PL+ and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
P/T Squib (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
(–)
PL+
(+)
NG
H01016
H08392
OK
H08396
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
DI–285
DIAGNOSTICS
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
→←
P/T Squib (LH)
PL+
PL–
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01017
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01084
DTC B0137/71
Tc
H02216
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PL+ and PL– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat
belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0137/71 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0137/71 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
–
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–286
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (LH).
→←
P/T Squib (LH)
ACC
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0137/71
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01084
Tc
H01220
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0137/71 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0137/71 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–287
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BL–20
DTC
B0138/72
Short in P/T Squib (LH) Circuit (to B+)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The P/T squib (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and seat belt pretensioner (LH).
It causes the SRS to deploy when the SRS deployment conditions are satisfied.
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B0138/72 is recorded when a B+ short is detected in the P/T squib (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Short circuit in seat belt pretensioner (LH) wire harness
(to B+)
P/T squib (LH) malfunction
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B0138/72
Seat belt pretensioner (LH)
Airbag sensor assembly
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–277.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check P/T squib (LH) circuit.
ON
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
(–)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between PL+ and
body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 0 V
PL+
(+)
NG
AB0119
H01016
H08394
OK
H08269
Repair or replace harness or connector between seat belt pretensioner (LH) and airbag
sensor assembly.
DI–288
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
P/T Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
PL+
PL–
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01017
H02139
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01085
DTC B0138/72
Tc
H02217
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the connector to the airbag sensor assembly.
(b) Using a service wire, connect PL+ and PL– of the connector (on the seat belt pretensioner side) between the seat
belt pretensioner (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0138/72 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0138/72 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
OK
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
DI–289
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check P/T squib (LH).
P/T Squib (LH)
→←
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B0138/72
E1
H01018
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01085
Tc
H01222
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the seat belt pretensioner (LH) connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B0138/72 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B0138/72 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace seat belt pretensioner (LH).
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check. If the malfunctioning part can not be
detected by the simulation method, replace all SRS components including the wire harness.
DI–290
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BM–27
DTC
B1100/31
Airbag Sensor Assembly Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The airbag sensor assembly consists of a airbag sensor, safing sensor, drive circuit, diagnosis circuit and
ignition control, etc.
It receives signals from the airbag sensor, judges whether or not the SRS must be activated, and detects
diagnosis system malfunction.
DTC B1100/31 is recorded when occurrence of a malfunction in the airbag sensor assembly is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Airbag sensor assembly malfunction
B1100/31
Airbag sensor assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
When a malfunction code other than code B1100/31 is displayed at the same time, first repair the malfunction
indicated by the malfunction code other than code B1100/31.
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–305)
2
Check voltage at IG2 and ACC of airbag sensor assembly.
ON
Airbag Sensor Assembly
ACC
(–)
AB0119
H01298
IG2
(+)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) Measure the voltage between body ground and terminals
each of IG2 and ACC of the airbag sensor assembly connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
H01299
NG
OK
Check that an abnormality occurs on the battery
and charging system.
DI–291
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Is DTC B1100/31 output again?
ACC
ON
or
DLC1
E1
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 FI1394
DTC B1100/31
Tc
PREPARATION:
Clear DTC.
(See step 5 on page DI–223)
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(c) Repeat operation in step (a) and (b) at least 5 times.
(d) Check DTC. (See page DI–223)
HINT:
Codes other than code B1100/31 may be output at this time, but
they are not relevant to this check.
H00022
NO
YES
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
Using simulation method, reproduce malfunction symptoms. (See page IN–19)
DI–292
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4LA–04
DTC
B1156/B1157/15
Front Airbag Sensor (RH) Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The front airbag sensor (RH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front airbag sensor (RH).
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B1156/B1157/15 is recorded when malfunction is detected in the front airbag sensor (RH) circuit.
DTC No.
B1156/B1157/15
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Front airbag sensor (RH)
Wire harness
Engine room main wire harness
Airbag sensor assembly
Front airbag sensor (RH) malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
SR+
SR–
B–W
2
II1
B–W
9
C5
BR–W
1
II1
BR–W
20
C5 SR–
2
1
SR+
H02750
DI–293
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check wire harness (to B+).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
ON
(+)
H03355
AB0119
H03363
(–)
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side)
between the front airbag sensor (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between body ground
and each of SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Voltage: Below 1 V
SR+
NG
SR–
Go to step 8.
H03445
OK
3
Check wire harness (to ground).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
(+)
(–)
H03353
H03361
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between body ground and
each of SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
SR+
SR–
H03443
NG
OK
Go to step 9.
DI–294
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness.
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
SR+
(+)
(–)
SR–
H03355
H03356
H09518
NG
Go to step 10.
OK
5
Check wire harness.
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SR+
SR–
(+)
(–)
H03353
H09521H03356
OK
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
SR+
PREPARATION:
Using a service wire, connect SR+ and SR– of the connector
(on the front airbag sensor (RH) side) between the airbag sensor assembly and the front airbag sensor (RH).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (RH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
SR–
H09523
NG
Go to step 11.
DI–295
DIAGNOSTICS
6
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SR+
OK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check front airbag sensor (RH).
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
H04504
H01062
–
(+)
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front airbag sensor (RH)), measure
the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 300 – 1500 Ω
SR–
(–)
H08346
NG
Replace front airbag sensor (RH).
DI–296
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
→←
ON
or
DLC1
DTC B1156/B1157/15
E1
H02757
AB0118 AB0119
R13006H01063
Tc
H04014
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front airbag sensor (RH) connector and airbag sensor assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See step 5 on page
DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B1156/B1157/15 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1156/B1157/15 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–297
DIAGNOSTICS
8
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check engine room main wire harness (to B+).
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
←→
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Engine Room Main
Wire Harness
ON
SR+
(–)
SR–
(+)
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the engine room main wire harness connector on
the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the RH front door wire harness
side) between the airbag sensor assembly and the engine room main wire harness, measure the voltage between body ground and each of SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Voltage: Below 1 V
NG
H03354
AB0119
H06141
H08272
Repair or replace engine room main wire harness.
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and engine room main
wire harness.
9
Check engine room main wire harness (to ground).
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Engine Room Main
Wire Harness
(–)
SR+
SR–
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the engine room main wire harness connector on
the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the engine room main wire harness side)
between the airbag sensor assembly and the engine room main
wire harness, measure the resistance between body ground
and each of SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
(+)
NG
H03354
H06140
Repair or replace engine room main wire harness.
H08258
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and engine room main
wire harness.
DI–298
DIAGNOSTICS
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check engine room main wire harness.
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Engine Room Main
Wire Harness
←→
SR+
H03354
H09519
–
(+)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SR–
(–)
H09520
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the engine room main wire harness connector on
the airbag sensor assembly side.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the engine room main wire harness side)
between the airbag sensor assembly and the engine room main
wire harness, measure the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
NG
Repair or replace engine room main wire harness.
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and engine room main
wire harness.
DI–299
DIAGNOSTICS
11
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check engine room main wire harness.
Engine Room Main
Wire Harness
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
←→
SR+
SR–
SR+
(+)
H03352
H09521 H09519
SR–
(–)
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire harness connector
on the airbag sensor assembly side.
(b) Using a service wire, connect SR+ and SR– of the connector (on the engine room main wire harness side) between the engine room main wire harness and the front
airbag sensor (RH).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the engine room main wire harness side)
between the airbag sensor assembly and the engine room main
wire harness, measure the resistance between SR+ and SR–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
H09522
NG
Repair or replace engine room main wire harness.
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector between airbag sensor assembly and engine room main
wire harness.
DI–300
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI4LB–03
DTC
B1158/B1159/16
Front Airbag Sensor (LH) Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The front airbag sensor (LH) circuit consists of the airbag sensor assembly and front airbag sensor (LH).
For details of the function of each component, see Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–2.
DTC B1158/B1159/16 is recorded when malfunction is detected in the front airbag sensor (LH) circuit.
DTC No.
B1158/B1159/16
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Front airbag sensor (LH)
Wire harness
Airbag sensor assembly
Front airbag sensor (LH) malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
SL+
SL–
Airbag Sensor Assembly
W–R
15
C5 SL+
BR
26
C5 SL–
2
1
H02751
DI–301
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection (See step 1 on page DI–305).
2
Check wire harness (to B+).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
ON
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ON.
(b) For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side)
between the front airbag sensor (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the voltage between body ground
and each of SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Voltage: Below 1 V
SL+
(+)
NG
H01370
AB0119
H08065
(–)
SL–
H08066
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
3
Check wire harness (to ground).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between body ground and
each of SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
(+)
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
SL+
NG
H01370
H08399
OK
(–)
SL–
H08400
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
DI–302
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check wire harness.
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
(+)
SL+
(–)
SL–
H01370
H08058
H09524
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
OK
5
Check wire harness.
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
SL+
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
SL–
(+)
(–)
H09526
H09521H08058
OK
SL+
SL–
H09525
PREPARATION:
Using a service wire, connect SL+ and SL– of the connector (on
the front airbag sensor (LH) side) between the airbag sensor
assembly and the front airbag sensor (LH).
CHECK:
For the connector (on the airbag sensor assembly side) between the front airbag sensor (LH) and the airbag sensor assembly, measure the resistance between SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector between front airbag sensor (LH) and airbag sensor assembly.
DI–303
DIAGNOSTICS
6
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check front airbag sensor (LH).
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
CHECK:
For the connector (on the front airbag sensor (LH)), measure
the resistance between SL+ and SL–.
OK:
Resistance: 300 – 1500 Ω
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
SL+
H01371
H01009
OK
(+)
SL–
(–)
H01155
NG
Replace front airbag sensor (LH).
DI–304
DIAGNOSTICS
7
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check airbag sensor assembly.
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
→←
ACC
→←
ON
or
DLC1
E1
H01369
AB0118 AB0119
R13006 H01064
DTC B1158/B1159/16
Tc
H01154
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the front airbag sensor (LH) connector and airbag sensor assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(b) Clear DTC stored in memory (See page DI–223).
(c) Turn ignition switch to LOCK, and wait at least for 20 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON, and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(e) Check DTC (See page DI–223).
OK:
DTC B1158/B1159/16 is not output.
HINT:
Codes other than code B1158/B1159/16 may be output at this
time, but they are not relevant to this check.
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
OK
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–305
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BN–12
DTC
Normal
Source Voltage Drop
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS is equipped with a voltage–increase circuit (DC–DC converter) in the airbag sensor assembly in
case the source voltage drops.
When the battery voltage drops, the voltage–increase circuit (DC–DC converter) functions to increase the
voltage of the SRS to normal voltage.
The diagnosis system malfunction display for this circuit is different from other circuits that is when the SRS
warning light remains lit up and the DTC is a normal code, source voltage drop is indicated.
Malfunction in this circuit is not recorded in the airbag sensor assembly, and the source voltage returns to
normal, the SRS warning light automatically goes off.
DTC No.
Diagnosis
(Normal)
Source voltage drop
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery
FL MAIN
B–G
Instrument Panel J/B
40A AM1
2
1
2
1K
W
Fusible Link Block
1
1
F11
F9
100A
ALT
2
F14
Instrument Panel J/B
4
5
W–R 5
W–R
2L
1B
1K
Ignition Switch
7
6
B–R
3
1K
2
3
L–R
6
1K
Junction
Connector
A W–B
IF
7
1J
30A AM2
5A IGN
15A CIG
B
B–R
1
1B
1
2A
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
4
1N
B–O
5
C5 IG2
2
1N
GR
6
C5 ACC
1
1N
W–B
27
C5 E1
Instrument Panel J/B
H02288
DI–306
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Prepare for inspection.
LOCK
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
D Squib
Spiral
Cable
P Squib
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
P/T Squib (RH)
AB0117
H02756
H02774
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(b) Remove the steering wheel pad (See Pub. No. RM654U
on page SR–11).
(c) Disconnect the connector of the front passenger airbag
assembly (See Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–28).
(d) Disconnect the connector of the seat belt pretensioner
RH and LH (See Pub. No. RM654U on page BO–126).
(e) Disconnect the connectors of the airbag sensor assembly
(See Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–59).
(f)
Disconnect the connector of the front airbag sensor RH
and LH (See Pub. No. RM654U on page RS–64).
CAUTION:
Store the steering wheel pad and front passenger airbag
assembly with the front surface facing upward.
DI–307
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check source voltage.
ON
Airbag Sensor Assembly
ACC
(–)
AB0119
H01298
IG2
(+)
H01299
PREPARATION:
Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
CHECK:
(a) Turn ignition switch ON.
(b) Measure the voltage each of IG2 and ACC on the sensor
and operate electric system (defogger, wiper, headlight,
heater blower, etc.).
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
NG
Check harness between battery and airbag sensor assembly, and check battery and charging
system.
OK
3
Does SRS warning light turn off?
ON
H01249
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Connect the steering wheel pad connector.
(c) Connect the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
(d) Connect the airbag sensor assembly connectors.
(e) Connect the seat belt pretensioner connectors.
(f)
Connect the front airbag sensor connectors.
(g) Turn ignition switch to ON.
CHECK:
Operate electric system (defogger, wiper, headlight, heater
blower, etc.) and check that SRS warning light goes off.
NO
Check for DTCs. If a DTC is output, perform troubleshooting for the DTC. If a normal code is output, replace airbag sensor assembly.
YES
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use the simulation method to check.
DI–308
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI64R–01
SRS Warning Light Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter.
When the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light lights up for approx. 6 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned from the LOCK position to ACC or ON position, and then turns off automatically.
If there is a malfunction in the SRS, the SRS warning light lights up to inform the driver of the abnormality.
When terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 are connected, the DTC is displayed by blinking the SRS warning
light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery
FL MAIN
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
3
LA C5
Fusible Link Block
1
1
F9
F11
B–G
J2 Junction
Connector
B–Y
1
2A
A
LG
13
7
2J
Instrument Panel J/B
SRS Warning Light
2
IE2
LG
A
B
Engine Room J/B No.2
10A
ECU–B
Short Pin
W–R
12
2
1G
3
1W
W–R
A
LG
DLC1
7
IG3
LG
5 AB
J2 Junction
Connector
19
TC C5
P–B
B
LG–R
B
11
IG3
LG–R
11
LG–R
B
TC
DLC2
4
TC
H02289
DI–309
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Always lit up, when ignition switch is in LOCK position
1
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–305)
2
Does SRS warning light turn off?
Airbag Sensor Assembly
LOCK
AB0117
H01293
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the airbag sensor assembly connector.
(d) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
CHECK:
Check operation of SRS warning light.
H01295
NO
YES
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
Check SRS warning light circuit or terminal AB
circuit of DLC1.
DI–310
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Does not light up, when ignition switch is turned to ACC or ON
1
Check ECU–B Fuse.
Fuse
N14677
PREPARATION:
Remove ECU–B fuse.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–B fuse.
OK:
Continuity
HINT:
Fuse may be burnt out even if it appears to be OK during
visual inspection.
If fuse is OK, install it.
NG
Go to step 5.
OK
2
Prepare for inspection. (See step 1 on page DI–305)
3
Check SRS warning light circuit.
Airbag Sensor Assembly
ON
(+)
LA
(–)
AB0119
H01300
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
(b) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage LA terminal of the harness side connector
of the airbag sensor assembly.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
H01301
NG
OK
Check SRS warning light bulb or repair SRS
warning light circuit.
DI–311
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Does SRS warning light come on?
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
P/T Squib (LH)
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
D Squib
PREPARATION:
(a) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(b) Connect the airbag sensor assembly connector.
(c) Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery, and
wait at least for 2 seconds.
(d) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
CHECK:
Check operation of SRS warning light.
Spiral
Cable
P Squib
Front Airbag
Sensor (RH)
P/T Squib (RH)
ON
H02755
AB0119 H10313
H10308
NO
Check terminal LA of airbag sensor assembly.
If normal, replace airbag sensor assembly.
YES
From the results of the above inspection, the malfunctioning part can now be considered normal.
To make sure of this, use simulation method to check.
DI–312
DIAGNOSTICS
5
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Is new ECU–B fuse burnt out again?
NO
YES
Check harness between ECU–B fuse and
SRS warning light.
Using simulation method, reproduce malfunction symptoms. (See page IN–19)
DI–313
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
DI1BQ–12
Tc Terminal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
By connecting terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 the airbag sensor assembly is set in the DTC output mode.
The DTCs are displayed by blinking the SRS warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
BR
3
E1
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
J2 Junction
Connector
DLC1
Tc
LG–R
11
11
IG3
LG–R
B
P–B
B
19
C5 Tc
A
J20
Junction Connector
DLC2
A
3
E1
Tc
LG–R
4
B
BR
Junction
Connector
BR
C
J6
B
J7
BR
6
IG3
J20
Junction Connector
BR
A
A
BR
EC
H08301
EC
H10309
DI–314
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the DTC is not displayed, do the following troubleshooting.
1
Does SRS warning light up for approx. 6 seconds?
LOCK
ACC
ON
PREPARATION:
Check operation of the SRS warning light after ignition switch
is turned from LOCK position to ACC or ON position.
or
AB0117 AB0118
H10313
AB0119
H10315
NO
Check SRS warning light system.
(See page DI–223)
YES
2
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
ACC
ON
or
E1
(–)
AB0118 AB0119
R14305
Tc
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
(+)
H00030
OK
NG
Go to step 4.
DI–315
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal Tc of DLC1 and body ground.
CHECK:
Measure the voltage between terminal Tc of DLC1 and body
ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
ACC
Tc
or
(–)
(+)
OK
AB0118 AB0119
R14304
H00031
Check harness between terminal E1 of DLC1
and body ground.
NG
4
Check airbag sensor assembly.
LOCK
ACC
ON
or
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Tc
AB0117 AB0118 AB0119
H01302
H01303
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the airbag sensor assembly connector.
(d) Insert service wire into terminal Tc from back side as
shown in the illustration.
(e) Connect the airbag sensor assembly connector with service wire.
(f)
Connect negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
(g) Turn ignition switch to ACC or ON and wait at least for 20
seconds.
(h) Connect service wire of terminal Tc to body ground.
CHECK:
Check operation of SRS warning light.
OK:
SRS waning light comes on.
NOTICE:
Pay due attention to the terminal connecting position to
avoid a malfunction.
OK
NG
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
Check harness between the airbag sensor assembly and DLC1.
DI–316
DIAGNOSTICS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
If the DTC is displayed without a DTC check procedure, perform the following
troubleshooting.
1
Check resistance between terminal Tc of airbag sensor assembly and body
ground.
Airbag Sensor Assembly
LOCK
Tc
(–)
AB0119
H01304
(+)
H01305
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch to LOCK.
(b) Disconnect negative (–) terminal cable from the battery,
and wait at least for 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the airbag sensor assembly connector.
CHECK:
Check resistance between terminal Tc of the airbag sensor assembly connector and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or Higher
NG
OK
Replace airbag sensor assembly.
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–317
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08F–12
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshoot in accordance with the procedure on the following page.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
Items inside
are titles of pages in this
manual with the page number indicated in the
bottom portion.
See the indicated pages
for detailed explanations.
Customer Problem Analysis
P. DI–318
2
Check and Clear DTC (Precheck)
P. DI–319
Symptom does not occur
3
4
Problem Symptom Confirmation
Symptom Simulation
P. IN–19
Symptom occurs
5
Normal code
DTC Check
P. DI–319
Malfunction code
6
7
DTC Chart
Problem Symptoms Table
P. DI–328
P. DI–324
9
8
Circuit Inspection
Input Signal Check
Parts Inspection
P. DI–329
Identification of Problem
Repair
NG
10
Confirmation Test
OK
Step 2, 5: Diagnostic steps permitting the use
of the TOYOTA hand–held tester or
TOYOTA break–out–box.
End
Author:
Date:
387
DI–318
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08G–09
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s name:
Registration No.
Registration Year
Customer’s Name
Frame No.
Date Vehicle
Brought in
/
/
Date of Problem
Occurrence
Condition of
How Often does
Problem Occurrence Problem Occurs
/
Continuous
Symptoms
/
Intermittent (
Vehicle Speed when
Problem Occurred
Auto cancel
occurs
km
Mile
Odometer Reading
Times a day)
km
Mile
Driving condition
City driving
Freeway
Up hill
Down hill
After cancel occurred, did the driver activate cruise control
again?
Yes
No
Cancel does not
occur
With brake ON
Except D position shift At 40 km/h (25 mph) or less
When control SW turns to CANCEL position
Cruise control
malfunction
Slip to acceleration side
Slip to deceleration side
Hunting occurs
O/D cut off does not occur
O/D does not return
Switch
malfunction
SET
ACCEL
COAST RESUME
CANCEL
Remains ON
Does not light up
1st Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
2nd Time
Normal Code
Malfunction Code (Code
)
DTC Check
Blinking
DI–319
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI1KS–04
PRE–CHECK
1.
(a)
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light
I00279
HINT:
If the indicator check result is not normal, proceed to troubleshooting (See page BE–1) for the combination meter section.
(b) Check the DTC.
HINT:
If a malfunction occurs in the No. 1 vehicle speed sensor or actuator, etc. during cruise control driving, the ECU actuates
AUTO CANCEL of the cruise control and turns on and off the
CRUISE MAIN indicator light to inform the driver of a malfunction. At the same time, the malfunction is stored in memory as
a DTC.
Indicator light
1.5 sec.
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Check the indicator.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Check that the CRUISE MAIN indicator light comes
ON when the cruise control main switch is turned
ON, and that the indicator light goes OFF when the
main switch is turned OFF.
0.5 sec.
ON
OFF
BE4034
(c)
DLC2
Tc
E1
I00169
Output of DTC using diagnosis check wire.
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2.
SST 09843–18020
(3) Read the DTC on the CRUISE MAIN indicator light.
DI–320
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
If the DTC is not output, inspect the diagnosis circuit (See page
DI–362).
As an example, the blinking patterns for codes; normal, 11 and
21 are shown in the illustration.
Normal code
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
Malfunction codes 11 and 21
0.5 sec.
4 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec. 2.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
ON
OFF
Code 11
BE4032
BE4033
Code 21
I00021
2.
(a)
(b)
DLC2
H07517
(b)
E1
(d) 5 times
within 3 seconds
DLC1
TC
(c)
I08438
USING TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
Hook up the TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC2.
Monitor the ECU data by following the prompts on the tester screen.
HINT:
TOYOTA hand–held tester has a ”Snapshot” function which records the monitored data.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
3.
DTC CLEARANCE (ERASE MODE)
HINT:
During in the erase mode, diag detection does not work.
(a) Stop the vehicle.
(b) Using SST, connect terminals Tc and E1 of DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(c) Pull the cruise control switch to CANCEL.
(d) On the above metioned condition, turn on the cruise control main switch 5 times within 3 seconds.
DI–321
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
4.
(a)
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CHECK (ROAD TEST)
Inspect the SET switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) Press the control switch to the SET/COAST.
(4) After releasing the switch, check that the vehicle
cruises at the desired speed.
(b)
Inspect the ACCEL switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) Check that the vehicle speed increases while the
control switch is turned to RES/ACC, and that the
vehicle cruises at the set speed when the switch is
released.
(4) Momentarily raise the control switch upward to the
RES/ACC position and then immediately release it.
Check that the vehicle speed increases by approx.
1.5 km/h (Tap–up function).
(c)
Inspect the COAST switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) Check that the vehicle speed decreases while the
control switch is turned to SET/COAST, and the vehicle cruises at the set speed when the switch is released.
(4) Momentarily pull the control switch down to SET/
COAST, and then immediately release it. Check
that the vehicle speed decreases by about 1.5 km/h
(Tap–down function).
N17520
N17520
N17520
DI–322
DIAGNOSTICS
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
Inspect the CANCEL switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) When operating one of the following operations,
check that the cruise control system is cancelled
and that the normal driving mode is reset.
Depress the brake pedal
Shift to except D position
Push the main switch OFF
Pull the cruise control switch to CANCEL
(e)
Inspect the RESUME switch.
(1) Push the main switch ON.
(2) Drive at a desired speed (40 km/h (25 mph) or higher).
(3) When operating one of the following operations
check that the cruise control system is cancelled
and that the normal driving mode is reset.
Depress the brake pedal
Shift to except D position
Push the main switch OFF
Pull the cruise control switch to CANCEL
(4) After the control switch is turned to RES/ACC at the
driving speed of more than 40 km/h (25 mph), check
that the vehicle restores the speed prior to the cancellation.
N17520
N17520
–
DI–323
DIAGNOSTICS
(1)
(2)
(1)
No.
N17520
–
5.
INPUT SIGNAL CHECK
HINT:
(1): For check No.1 – No.3
Turn ignition switch ON.
(2): For check No.4
Jack up the vehicle.
Start the engine.
Shift to D position.
(a) Pull the control switch to SET/COAST or RES/ACC position and hold it down or up (1).
(b) Push the main switch ON (2).
(c) Check that the CRUISE MAIN indicator light blinks twice
or 3 times repeatedly after 3 seconds.
(d) Turn the SET/COAST or RES/ACC switch OFF.
(e) Operate each switch as listed in the table below.
(f)
Read the blinking pattern of the CRUISE MAIN indicator
light.
(g) After performing the check, turn the main switch OFF.
HINT:
When 2 or more signals are input to the ECU, the lowest numbered code will be displayed first.
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Operation Method
0.25 sec.
1
Turn SET/COAST switch ON
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Light
ON
0.25 sec.
SET/COAST switch circuit
is normal
1sec.
OFF
ON
2
Turn RES/ACC switch ON
Light
RES/ACC switch circuit
is normal
OFF
Turn CANCEL switch ON
ON
Switch ON
OFF
Turn stop light switch ON
Depress brake pedal
ON
Turn PNP switch OFF
(Shift to except D position)
Light
Drive at about 40 km/h
(25 mph)or higher
Light
Drive at about 40 km/h
(25 mph) or below
Light
OFF
4
CANCEL switch circuit
is normal
Switch OFF
Light
3
Diagnosis
Stop light switch circuit
is normal
Switch ON
Switch OFF
PNP switch circuit is
normal
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
Vehicle Speed Sensor is
normal
DI–324
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08I–09
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit listed for that code in the table
below and proceed to the appropriate page.
DTC No.
(See Page)
Circuit Inspection
Trouble Area
Actuator Motor Circuit
Actuator motor
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
actuator motor
Cruise control ECU
12
(DI–331)
Actuator Magnetic Clutch Circuit
STOP Fuse
Stop light switch
Actuator magnetic clutch
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
actuator magnetic clutch, actuator magnetic clutch and body
ground
Cruise control ECU
14
(DI–334)
Actuator Mechanical Malfunction
Actuator motor (actuator lock: motor, arm)
Cruise control ECU
21
(DI–336)
Open in Vehicle Speed Sensor Circuit
Combination meter
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and combination meter, combination meter and vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor
Cruise control ECU
23
(DI–339)
Vehicle Speed Signal Abnormal
Vehicle speed sensor
Cruise control ECU
Control Switch Circuit
Cruise control switch
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and cruise
control switch, cruise control switch and body ground
Cruise control ECU
41
Cruise control ECU
Cruise control ECU
42
Source voltage drop
Power source
Idle Signal Circuit
Throttle position sensor
Harness or connector between ECM and throttle position
sensor
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and ECM
Cruise control ECU
11, 15
(DI–329)
32
(DI–340)
51
(DI–343)
DI–325
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08J–09
PARTS LOCATION
Cruise Control Actuator
Actuator Motor
Actuator Magnetic Clutch
Stop Light Switch
Cruise Control switch
Main Switch
Control Switch
Cruise Control ECU
Instrument Panel Junction Block No.1
ECU–IG Fuse
STOP Fuse
DLC2
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Park/Neutral Position Switch
I08453
DI–326
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI1KT–07
TERMINALS OF ECU
C16
I00293
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
STP ↔ GND
STP–
(C16–2 ↔ C16–16)
G W ↔ W–B
G–W
W B
D ↔ GND (C16–3
(C16 3 ↔ C16–16)
C16 16)
B R ↔ W–B
B–R
W B
PI ↔ GND (C16–4
(C16 4 ↔ C16–16)
C16 16)
TC ↔ GND
(C16–5 ↔ C16–16)
ECT ↔ GND
(C16–6 ↔ C16–16)
O ↔ W–B
W B
LG–R ↔ W–B
L B ↔ W–B
L–B
W B
MC ↔ GND
(C16–7 ↔ C16–16)
R B ↔ W–B
R–B
W B
L ↔ GND
(C16–8 ↔ C16–16)
G B ↔ W–B
G–B
W B
B ↔ GND
(C16–9 ↔ C16–16)
B–R ↔ W–B
CCS ↔ GND
(C16–10 ↔ C16–16)
W ↔ W–B
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
Depress brake pedal
10 – 16 V
Release brake pedal
Below 1 V
Shift to positions except D
Below 1 V
Shift to D position
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
Cruise control main switch ON
Below 1.2 V
Ignition switch ON
Cruise control main switch OFF
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
Connect terminals Tc and E1 of diagnostic check connector
Below 1 V
During driving
Gear position 3rd
10 – 16 V
During driving
Gear position O/D
Below 1 V
During cruise control driving
COAST switch held ON
9 – 15 V
During cruise control driving
ACC switch held ON
Below 1 V
During cruise control driving
9 – 15 V
Except during cruise control driving
Below 1 V
Ignition switch ON
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
CANCEL switch held ON
4.2 – 8.8 V
Ignition switch ON
SET/COAST switch held ON
2.5 – 6.3 V
Ignition switch ON
RES/ACC switch held ON
0.8 – 3.7 V
DI–327
DIAGNOSTICS
Symbols (Terminals No.)
W L ↔ W–B
W–L
W B
SPD ↔ GND
(C16 12 ↔ C16–16)
(C16–12
C16 16)
V–W
V
W↔W
W–B
B
OD ↔ GND
(C16–14 ↔ C16–16)
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Wiring Color
CMS ↔ GND
(C16–11 ↔ C16–16)
IDL ↔ GND
(C16–13 ↔ C16–16)
–
Condition
Ignition switch ON
Main switch OFF
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
Main switch ON
Below 0.5 V
Engine start
Car stoppage.
During driving (Pulse generated).
L R ↔ W–B
L–R
W B
Y B ↔ W–B
Y–B
W B
MO ↔ GND
(C16–15 ↔ C16–16)
R G ↔ W–B
R–G
W B
GND ↔ Body Ground
(C16–16 ↔ Body Ground)
W–B ↔ Body
Ground
STD Voltage (V)
Below 1.5 V or
4.7 – 16 V
3–7V
Ignition switch ON
Throttle valve fully opened.
10 – 16 V
Ignition switch ON
Throttle valve fully closed.
Below 1.5 V
During cruise control driving
OD switch ON.
10 – 16 V
During cruise control driving
OD switch OFF (3rd driving)
Below 1 V
During cruise control driving
ACC switch hold ON
9 – 15 V
During cruise control driving
COAST switch hold ON
Below 1 V
Constant
Below 1 V
DI–328
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08L–14
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
SET not occourring or CANCEL occurring.
(DTC is Normal)
1. Main Switch Circuit
(Cruise control switch)
2. Vehicle Speed Sensor
3. Control Switch Circuit
(Cruise control switch)
4. Stop Light Switch Circuit
5. Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
6. Actuator Motor Circuit
7. Cruise Control Cable
8. Cruise Control ECU
SET not occurring or CANCEL occurring.
(DTC dose not output)
1. ECU Power Source Circuit
2. Cruise Control ECU
DI–355
IN–29
DI–364
DI–339
Actual vehicle speed deviates above or below the set speed.
1. Cruise Control Cable
2. Vehicle Speed Signal Abnormal
3. Electronically Controlled Transmission
Communication Circuit
4. Actuator Motor Circuit
5. Idle Signal Circuit
(Main throttle position sensor)
6. Cruise Control ECU
DI–358
DI–336
DI–340
DI–346
DI–352
DI–329
DI–364
IN–29
DI–349
DI–329
DI–343
IN–29
Gear shifting frequent between 3rd O/D when driving on uphill
road. (Hurting)
1. Electronically Controlled Transmission
Communication Circuit
2. Cruise Control ECU
DI–349
IN–29
Cruise control not cancelled, even when brake pedal is depressed.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Stop Light Switch Circuit
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–364
DI–346
DI–329
IN–29
Cruise control not cancelled, even when transmission is shifted to
”N” postion.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–364
DI–352
DI–329
IN–29
Control switch does not operate.
(SET/COAST, ACC/RES, CANCEL not possible)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Control Switch Circuit
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–364
DI–340
DI–329
IN–29
SET possible at 40 km/h (25 mph) or less, or CANCEL does not
operate at 40 km/h (25 mph) or less.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Cruise Control Cable
Vehicle Speed Signal Abnormal
Actuator Motor Circuit
Cruise Control ECU
DI–364
DI–339
DI–329
IN–29
Poor response is in ACCEL and RESUME modes.
1. Cruise Control Cable
2. Electronically Controlled Transmission
Communication Circuit
3. Actuator Motor Circuit
4. Cruise Control ECU
O/D does not resume, even though the road is not uphill.
1. Electronically Controlled Transmission
Communication Circuit
2. Cruise Control ECU
DI–349
IN–29
DTC memory is erased.
1. Cruise Control ECU
IN–29
DTC is not output, or is output when should not be.
1. Diagnosis Circuit
2. Cruise Control ECU
DI–362
IN–29
Cruise MAIN indicator light remains ON or falls to light up.
1. Cruise MAIN Indicator Light Switch Circuit
DI–360
DI–364
DI–349
DI–329
IN–29
DI–329
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08M–13
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
DTC
11, 15
Actuator Motor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The actuator motor is operated by signals from the ECU. Acceleration and deceleration signals are transmitted according to changes in the Duty Ratio (See below).
Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle. For example, if A is the period of continuity
in one cycle, and B is the period of non–continuity.
A
A
Duty Ratio =
A+B
DTC No.
ON
x 100 (%)
B
1 cycle
OFF
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
11
Short in actuator motor circuit.
Actuator motor
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
actuator motor
Cruise control ECU
15
Open in actuator motor circuit.
Actuator motor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
Cruise Control Actuator
Actuator Motor
1
C3
15
R–G
2
C3
C16 MO
7
R–B
C16 MC
N21216
DI–330
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check resistance between terminals MO and MC of actuator motor.
ON
2
1
I00004
I00151
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch ON.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2.
HINT:
If control plate is in fully opened or fully closed positions, resistance can not be measured.
OK:
Resistance: more than 4.2 Ω
NG
Replace cruise control actuator.
OK
2
Check for open and short in harness and connectors between cruise control
ECU and actuator motor (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–331
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08N–13
DTC
12
Actuator Magnetic Clutch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit turns on the magnetic clutch inside the actuator during cruise control operation according to the
signal from the ECU. If a malfunction occurs in the actuator or speed sensor, etc. during cruise control operation, the rotor shaft between the motor and control plate is released.
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stop light switch turns on, supplying electrical power to the stop light.
Power supply to the magnetic clutch is mechanically cut and the magnetic clutch is turned OFF.
When driving downhill, if the vehicle speed exceeds the set speed by 15 km/h (9 mph), the ECU turns the
safety magnet clutch OFF. If the vehicle speed later drops to within 10 km/h (6 mph), cruise control at the
set speed is resumed.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
STOP Fuse
Stop light switch
Actuator magnetic clutch
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
actuator magnetic clutch, actuator magnetic clutch and body
ground
Cruise control ECU
Short in actuator magnetic clutch circuit.
Open (0.8 sec.) in actuator magnetic clutch circuit.
12
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
A
J6
J/C
Cruise Control Actuator
Actuator Magnetic Clutch
A
J6
4
W–B
3
R–Y
Stop Light Switch
4
3
1
2
8
C16
G–B
L
W–B
8
1J
Instrument
Panel J/B
7
1J
Stop Lights
STOP Fuse
W–B
A
J9
J/C
IF
I00281
DI–332
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check STOP fuse.
Instrument panel junction block No.1:
STOP Fuse
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(b) Remove the STOP fuse from instrument panel junction
block No.1.
CHECK:
Check fuse continuity.
OK:
There is continuity.
I00157
NG
Replace STOP fuse.
OK
2
Check stop light switch.
2
4
1
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the stop light switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals.
3
I00133
NG
OK
Switch position
Continuity
Switch pin free
(Brake pedal depressed)
1–2
Switch pin pushed in
(Brake pedal released)
3–4
Replace stop light switch.
DI–333
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check resistance between terminals L and GND of actuator magnetic clutch.
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and 4.
OK:
Resistance: 34.65 – 42.35 Ω
4
3
I00311
NG
Replace cruise control actuator.
OK
4
Check for open and short in harness and connectors between cruise control
ECU and actuator magnetic clutch, actuator magnetic clutch and body ground
(See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–334
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08O–13
DTC
14
Actuator Mechanical Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The circuit detects the rotation position of the actuator control plate and sends a signal to the ECU.
DTC No.
14
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Cruise control actuator mechanical malfunction.
Actuator lock: (motor, arm)
Actuator motor
Cruise control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–329.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check cruise control actuator arm locking operation
4
(+)
(–)
3
I00055
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
CHECK:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to the terminal 3
of actuator and the negative (–) lead to terminal 4.
NOTICE:
Do not connect the high tension cables to the wrong battery terminal. The cruise control actuator will be damaged.
Move the control plate by hand.
OK:
Control plate doesn’t move.
NG
OK
Replace cruise control actuator.
DI–335
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check cruise control actuator operation.
PREPARATION:
(a) Turn ignition switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the actuator connector.
CHECK:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminals 1 and
3 of actuator, connect the negative (–) lead to terminals 2 and
4 of actuator.
OK:
Control arm moves to fully open side
Fully open side
4
1
3
2
Control plate
CHECK:
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminals 2 and
3 of actuator, connect the negative (–) lead to terminals 1 and
4 of actuator.
OK:
Control arm moves to fully colsed side
Fully Closed side
4
1
3 2
Control plate
I08437
NG
Replace cruise control actuator.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and cruise control actuator (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–336
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08P–13
DTC
21
Open in Vehicle Speed Sensor Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The signal from the vehicle speed sensor circuit is sent to cruise control ECU as vehicle speed signal.
The rotor shaft is driven by the gear of the transmission.
For each rotation of the shaft, the vehicle speed sensor sends a 4–pulse signal through the combination
meter to the cruise control ECU (See the following installation).
This signal is converted inside the combination meter and sent as a 4–pulse signal to the cruise control ECU.
The ECU calculates the vehicle speed from this pulse frequency.
4 pulses/
4 pulses/
1 rotation
1 rotation
of rotor shaft
of rotor shaft
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Combination Meter
ECU
DTC No.
21
Cruise Control ECU
DTC Detecting Condition
I00292
Trouble Area
Speed signal is not input to the cruise control ECU while cruise
control is set.
Combination meter
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and combination meter, combination meter and vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor
Cruise control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
Combination Meter
15
C11
L
P
7
2
IH1
14
3
C11
IF1
V–W
B
V–W
12
B
C16
V–W
SPD
6
IH1
L
3
SI
C12
Speedo
–meter
J15
J/C
P
2
SE
Speed
Sensor
IG+
1
to GAUGE Fuse
R–L
I00282
DI–337
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Input signal check.
Input Signal
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Drive at about
40 km/h (25 mph)
or below
Light
Drive at about
40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher
Light ON
OFF
ON
OFF
CHECK:
(a) See input signal check on page DI–319.
(b) Check indicator light operation when driving with vehicle
speed above 40 km/h (25 mph), and with vehicle speed
below 40 km/h (25 mph).
OK:
Vehicle speed above 40 km/h (25 mph):
Indicator light blinks
Vehicle speed below 40 km/h (25 mph):
Indicator light stays on
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
NG
2
Check speedometer circuit (See Combination meter troubleshooting on page
BE–1).
NG
Repair or replace harness, connector or combination meter assembly.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and combination meter, combination meter and vehicle speed sensor (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–338
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check vehicle speed sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U on page BE–47).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Replace vehicle speed sensor.
DI–339
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08Q–11
DTC
23
Vehicle Speed Signal Abnormal
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
See page DI–336.
DTC No.
23
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Vehicle speed sensor
Cruise control ECU
Vehicle speed sensor pulse is abnormal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–336.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check vehicle speed sensor (See Pub. No. RM654U on page BE–47).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Replace vehicle speed sensor.
DI–340
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08R–13
DTC
32
Control Switch Circuit (Cruise Control
Switch)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit carries the SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL and CANCEL signals (each voltage) to the ECU.
DTC No.
32
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Cruise control switch
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and
cruise control switch, cruise control switch and body ground
Cruise control ECU
Short in control switch circuit.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control Switch
Main Switch
Control Switch
MAIN
Cruise Control ECU
11
CMS 5
C16
W–L
CANCEL
CMS
SET/COAST
RES/ACC
3 EP
10
CCS 4
C16
W
A
J6
W–B
J9
J/C
Instrument Panel J/B
A
W–B
7
8
1J
1J
A
J/C
CCS
A
J7
16
C16
W–B
GND
J6
W–B
IF
I00283
DI–341
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Input signal check.
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Input Signal
SET/COAST
switch
2 Pulses
ON
OFF
RESUME/ACCEL
switch
OFF
ON
CANCEL switch
3 Pulses
ON
SW OFF
OFF
SW ON
PREPARATION:
See input signal check on page DI–319.
CHECK:
Check the indicator light operation when each of the SET/
COAST, RESUME/ACCEL and CANCEL is turned on.
OK:
SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL switch
The signals shown in the table on the left should be
output when each switch is ON. The signal should
disappear when the switch is turned OFF.
CANCEL switch
The indicator light goes off when the cancel switch is
turned ON.
OK
Wait and see.
NG
2
Check voltage between terminals CCS of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals 18 of ECU connector and
body ground, when each of the SET/COAST, RESUME/ACCEL and CANCEL is turned ON.
ON
CCS
(–)
(+)
AB0119
I00168
I00171
OK
NG
Switch position
Resistance (V)
Neutral
10 – 16 V
RES/ACC
0.8 – 3.7 V
SET/COAST
2.5 – 6.3 V
CANCEL
4.2 – 8.8 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
DI–342
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check control switch.
4
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove steering wheel center pad.
(b) Disconnect the control switch connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and 4 of control switch
connector when control switch is operated.
3
N16045
NG
Switch position
Resistance (Ω)
Neutral
∞ (No continuity)
RES/ACC
50 – 80
SET/COAST
180 – 220
CANCEL
400 – 440
Replace control switch.
OK
4
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and cruise control switch,
cruise control switch and body ground (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Wait and see.
OK
5
Input signal check (See step 1).
NG
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
DI–343
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08S–11
DTC
51
Idle Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the idle switch is turned ON, a signal is sent to the ECU. The ECU uses this signal to correct the discrepancy between the throttle valve position and the actuator position sensor value to enable accurate
cruise control at the set speed. If the idle switch is malfunctioning, problem symptoms also occur in the engine, so also inspect the engine.
DTC No.
51
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
Harness or connector between ECM and throttle position
sensor
Throttle position sensor
Harness or connector between cruise control ECU and ECM
Cruise control ECU
Short in idle signal circuit.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
ECM
IDLO
3
E4
L–R
13
C16
IDL
N21220
DI–344
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal IDL of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Disconnect the ECM connector.
(c) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal IDL of ECU connector and
body ground when the throttle valve is fully closed and fully
opened.
OK:
ON
IDL
(–)
AB0119
I00167
(+)
I00172
OK
Throttle valve position
Voltage
Fully opened
10 – 14 V
Fully closed
Below 2 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
NG
2
Check harness and connector between ECM and throttle position sensor (See
page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
3
Check throttle position sensor circuit (See page DI–39).
NG
OK
Replace throttle position sensor.
DI–345
DIAGNOSTICS
4
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check throttle position sensor.
PREPARATION:
Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminals 3 and 4 of throttle position sensor connector when the throttle valve is fully closed and
fully opened.
OK:
Throttle Position Sensor
3
4
I00052
NG
Throttle valve position
Resistance
Fully opened
1 MΩ or higher
Fully closed
Below 2.3 kΩ
Replace throttle position sensor.
OK
5
Check for open and short in harness and connector between cruise control ECU
and ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU (See
page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–346
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08T–12
Stop Light Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stop light switch sends a signal to the ECU. When the ECU receives
this signal, it cancels the cruise control.
A fail–safe function is provided so that the cancel functions normally, even if there is a malfunction in the stop
light signal circuit.
The cancel conditions are: Battery positive voltage at terminal STP–
When the brake is ON, battery positive voltage normally is applied through the STOP fuse and stop light
switch to terminal STP– of the ECU, and the ECU turns the cruise control OFF.
If the harness connected to terminal STP– has an open circuit, terminal STP– will have battery positive voltage and the cruise control will be turned OFF.
Also, when the brake is ON, the magnetic clutch circuit is cut mechanically by the stop light switch, turning
the cruise control OFF. (See page DI–331 for operation of the magnetic clutch)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
Stop Light Switch
Instrument Panel J/B
2
1
G–W
3
4
1R
5
1R
J23
J/C
A
G–W
A
G–W
2
C16
STP–
4
R–Y
8
W
C16
G–B
Instrument Panel J/B
7
1C
STOP
1
F9
ALT
Cruise Control
Actuator
3
4
4
1B
B–R
FL BLOCK
W–B
A
J6
1
F14
B–G
FL MAIN
J/C
A
J6
Instrument Panel J/B
J9
J/C
A
W–B
Battery
L
7
1J
W–B
8
1J
IF
I08461
DI–347
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of stop light.
CHECK:
Check that stop light comes ON when brake pedal is depressed, and turns OFF when brake pedal is released.
NG
Check stop light system (See page BE–1).
OK
2
Input signal check.
Input Signal
Stop Light
switch ON
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
OFF
Light
ON
SW OFF
SW ON
CHECK:
(a) See input signal check on DI–319.
(b) Check the indicator light when the brake pedal is depressed.
OK:
The indicator light goes OFF when the brake pedal is
depressed.
OK
NG
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
DI–348
DIAGNOSTICS
3
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal STP– of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connectors still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal STP– of cruise control ECU
connector and body ground, when the brake pedal is depressed and released.
OK:
ON
STP–
(–)
(+)
OK
AB0119
I00142
–
Depressed
10 – 14 V
Released
Below 1 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
I00173
NG
4
Check for open in harness and connectors between terminal STP– of cruise control ECU and stop light switch (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–349
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08U–12
Electronically Controlled Transmission Communication Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When driving uphill under the cruise control, in order to reduce shifting due to ON–OFF overdrive operation
and to provide smooth driving, when down shifting in the electronically controlled transmission occurs, a signal to prevent upshift until the end of the uphill slope is sent from the cruise control ECU to the electronically
controlled transmission.
Terminal ECT of the cruise control ECU detects the shift change signal (output to electronically controlled
transmission No. 2 solenoid) from the ECM.
If the vehicle speeds down, also when terminal ECT of the cruise control ECU receives down shifting signal,
it sends a signal from terminal OD to ECM to cut overdrive until the end of the uphill slope, and the gear shifts
are reduced and gear shift points in the electronically controlled transmission are changed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
ECM
OD1
S2
20
E4
6
E6
14
OD
C16
Y–B
J19
J/C
L–B
L–B
B
B
L–B
7
IG2
L–B
6 ECT
C16
ECT No.2
Solenoid
I08462
DI–350
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check operation of overdrive.
PREPARATION:
Test drive after engine warms up.
CHECK:
Check that overdrive ON ↔ OFF occurs by operation of OD switch ON–OFF.
NG
Check and repair electronically controlled
transmission (See page DI–133).
OK
2
Check voltage between terminal OD of harness side connector of cruise control
ECU and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
(c) Disconnect the ECU connector.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal OD of harness side connector of ECU and body ground.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
O/D
(–)
(+)
AB0119
I00143
I00174
NG
OK
Go to step 5.
DI–351
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal ECT of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground (On test drive).
(–)
(+)
ECT
PREPARATION:
(a) Connect the ECU connector.
(b) Test drive after engine warms up.
CHECK:
Check voltage between terminal ECT of ECU connector and
body ground when OD switch is ON and OFF.
OK:
I00141
OK
OD switch position
Voltage
ON
8 – 14 V
OFF
Below 0.5 V
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
NG
4
Check harness and connector between terminal ECT of cruise control ECU and
electronically controlled transmission solenoid (See page IN–29).
NG
Repair or replace harness or connector.
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU.
5
Check harness and connector between terminal OD of cruise control ECU and
terminal OD1 of ECM (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU (See
page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–352
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08V–12
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the shift position is except D, a signal is sent from the park/neutral position switch to the ECU. When
this signal is input during cruise control driving, the ECU cancels the cruise control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
J19
J/C
PNP Switch
10
2
D
D
9
IG2
B–R
R–L
J22
J/C
A
A
B–R
B–R
3
C16
D
R–L
Instrument Panel J/B
2
IG2
F
J24
R–L
J/C
F
J24
1
1J
R–L
GAUGE
1
1K
B–Y
Instrument Panel J/B
1
1B
Ignition Switch
2
1K
AM1
2
AM1
IG1 4
W
B–R
FL BLOCK
1
F14
ALT
1
F9
FL MAIN
B–G
Battery
I08463
DI–353
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check starter operation.
CHECK:
Check that the starter operates normally and that the engine starts.
NG
Proceed to engine troubleshooting
(See Pub. No. RM654U on page ST–1).
OK
2
Input signal check.
Input Signal
Indicator Light
Blinking Pattern
Turn PNP switch
ON SW ON
OFF (Shift to posi- Light
SW OFF
tions except D )
OFF
PREPARATION:
See input signal check on page DI–319.
CHECK:
Check the indicator light when shifting into positions except D.
OK:
The indicator light goes off when shifting into positions except D.
OK
NG
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
DI–354
DIAGNOSTICS
3
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check voltage between terminal D of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal D of ECU connector and
body ground when shifting into D position and other positions.
OK:
ON
D
(–)
AB0119
I00139
–
Shift Position
Voltage
D position
10 – 14 V
Other positions
Below 1 V
(+)
I00175
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
NG
4
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and park/neutral
position switch (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–355
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08X–12
ECU Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECU power source supplies power to the actuator and sensors, etc, when terminal GND and the cruise
control ECU case are grounded.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
Instrument Panel J/B
Ignition Switch
2 AM1
IG1 4
B–Y
1
1K
9
1J
ECU–IG
J12
J/C
C
C
B–R
B–R
9
C16
B
W
Instrument Panel J/B
FL BLOCK
1
F9
1
F14
B–R
1
1B
AM1
2
1K
B–G
J9
J/C
FL MAIN
Battery
A
W–B
Instrument Panel J/B
7
8
1J
1J
W–B
A J/C A
J7
J6
W–B
16
C16 GND
IF
I08464
DI–356
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check ECU–IG fuse.
Instrument panel junction block No.1:
ECU–IG
Fuse
PREPARATION:
Remove the ECU–IG fuse from instrument panel junction block
No.1.
CHECK:
Check continuity of ECU–IG fuse.
OK:
Continuity
I00157
NG
Check for short in all the harness and components connected to ECU–IG fuse.
OK
2
Check voltage between terminals B and GND of cruise control ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals B and GND of ECU connector.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
B
GND
(–)
(+)
AB0119
I00147
I00176
OK
NG
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
DI–357
DIAGNOSTICS
3
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check resistance between terminal GND of cruise control ECU connector and
body ground.
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal GND of ECU connector
and body ground.
OK:
Resistance: Below 1 Ω
GND
I00140
NG
OK
Check and repair harness and connector between cruise control ECU and battery
(See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–358
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI08Z–17
Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the cruise control main switch is turned OFF, the cruise control does not operate.
WIRING DIAGRAM
See page DI–340.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminal CMS of cruise control ECU connector and body
ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the ECU with connector still connected.
(b) Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminal CMS of cruise control ECU
connector when main switch is held ON and OFF.
OK:
ON
CMS
(–)
(+)
Main switch
Voltage
OFF
10 – 14 V
ON
Below 0.5 V
AB0119
I00145
I00177
OK
NG
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
DI–359
DIAGNOSTICS
2
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Check main switch continuity.
3
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove steering wheel pad
(See Pub. No. RM654U on page SR–11).
(b) Disconnect the control switch connector.
CHECK:
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 of control switch
connector when main switch is held ON and OFF.
OK:
5
N15969
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
3–5
No continuity
Hold ON
3–5
Continuity
NG
Replace control switch.
OK
3
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and main switch
(See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–360
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI090–20
CRUISE MAIN Indicator Light Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the cruise control main switch is turned ON, CRUISE MAIN indicator light lights up.
WIRING DIAGRAM
CRUISE MAIN
Indicator Light
J3
(in Combination Meter)
J/C
7
10
D
D
C12
C12
O
R–L
Cruise Control ECU
J1
J/C
5
IE2
4
D
D
O
O
PI
C16
R–L
Instrument Panel J/B
2
1D
GAUGE
1
1K
Ignition Switch
4 IG1
B–G
ALT
W
Instrument Panel J/B
FL BLOCK
1
F9
AM1 2
B–Y
1
F14
B–R
1
1B
AM1
2
1K
FL MAIN
Battery
I08465
DI–361
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals PI and GND of cruise control ECU connector.
PREPARATION:
Tun ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals PI and GND of cruise control ECU connector when main switch is ON and OFF.
OK:
ON
PI
(–)
AB0119
I00144
Switch position
Voltage
OFF
10 – 16 V
ON
Below 1.2 V
(+)
I00178
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
NG
2
Check combination meter (See page BE–1).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Replace combination meter.
DI–362
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI091–12
Diagnosis Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a signal to the ECU that outputs DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Cruise Control ECU
J1
J/C
D
4
D
C16
PI
O
O
10 D2
DLC2
J2
J/C
4 D2
B
5
B
C16
LG–R
LG–R
TC
B
LG–R
11 IG3
DLC1
11
D1
LG–R
I00291
DI–363
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2.
PREPARATION:
Turn ignition switch ON.
CHECK:
Measure voltage between terminals Tc and E1 of DLC2.
OK:
Voltage: 10 – 14 V
ON
AB0119
I00169
TC
E1
I00179
OK
Proceed to next circuit inspection shown on
problem symptoms table (See page DI–328).
NG
2
Check harness and connector between cruise control ECU and DLC2, DLC2 and
body ground (See page IN–29).
NG
OK
Check and replace cruise control ECU
(See page IN–29).
Repair or replace harness or connector.
DI–364
DIAGNOSTICS
–
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DI092–08
Actuator Control Cable
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Actuator control cable inspection
OK:
(a) Check that the actuator and control cable throttle link are properly installed and that the cable and link
are connected correctly.
(b) Check that the actuator and bell crank operate smoothly.
(c) Check that the cable is not loose or too tight.
OK:
Freeplay: less than 10 mm
HINT:
If the control cable is very loose, the vehicle’s loss of speed going uphill will be large.
If the control cable is too tight, the idle RPM will become high.
CL–1
CLUTCH
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
CL034–01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Clutch grabs/chatters
1. Engine mounting (Loosen)
2. Clutch disc (Runout is excessive)
3. Clutch disc (Oily)
4. Clutch disc (Worn out)
5. Clutch disc torsion rubber (Damaged)
6. Clutch disc (Glazed)
7. Diaphragm spring (Out of tip alignment)
–
CL–17
CL–17
CL–17
CL–17
CL
17
CL–17
CL
17
CL–19
Clutch pedal
edal spongy
s ongy
1. Clutch line (Air in line)
2. Master cylinder cup
cu (Damaged)
3. Release cylinder cup (Damaged)
–
CL–4
CL 4
CL–9
Clutch noisy
1. Release bearing (Worn,
1
(Worn dirty,
dirty or damaged)
2 Clutch
2.
Cl h disc
di torsion
i rubber
bb (Damaged)
(D
d)
CL–19
CL
19
CL 17
CL–17
Cl t h slips
Clutch
li
1. Clutch pedal
edal (Free
(Freeplay
lay out of adjustment)
2. Clutch disc (Oily)
3. Clutch disc (Worn out)
4. Dia
Diaphragm
hragm sspring
ring (Damaged)
5. Pressure plate
late (Distortion)
6. Flywheel (Distortion)
CL–2
CL–17
CL–17
CL
17
CL–17
CL
17
CL–17
CL
17
–
Cl t h does
Clutch
d
nott disengage
di
1. Clutch pedal (Freeplay out of adjustment)
1
2 Clutch line (Air in line)
2.
3 Master cylinder cup (Damaged)
3.
4 Release cylinder cup (Damaged)
4.
5 Clutch disc (out of true)
5.
6 Clutch
6.
Cl tch disc (Runout
(R no t is excessive)
e cessi e)
7 Cl
7.
Clutch
t h di
disc (Li
(Lining
i b
broken)
k )
8 Clutch
8.
Cl t h disc
di (Dirty
(Di t or burned)
b
d)
9. Cl
Clutch
h di
disc (Oil
(Oily))
10. Clutch disc (Lack of spline grease)
11. Diaphragm
g spring
g ((Damaged)
g )
12. Diaphragm
g spring
g (Out
(
of tip alignment)
g
)
13. Pressure plate (Distortion)
CL–2
–
CL 4
CL–4
CL 9
CL–9
CL 17
CL–17
CL 17
CL–17
CL 17
CL–17
CL 17
CL–17
CL
CL–17
CL–19
CL–17
CL–19
CL–17
Author:
Date:
1780
CL–2
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH PEDAL
CLUTCH PEDAL
CL035–01
INSPECTION
1.
Pedal Height
Adjust Point
Push Rod Play
and Freeplay
Adjust Point
Push Rod Play
Pedal Height
Q10088
CHECK THAT PEDAL HEIGHT IS CORRECT
Pedal height from asphalt sheet:
1MZ–FE: 161.8 – 171.8 mm (6.370 – 6.764 in.)
5S–FE: 156.8 – 166.8 mm (6.173 – 6.567 in.)
2.
IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PEDAL HEIGHT
Loosen the lock nut and turn the stopper bolt until the height is
correct. Tighten the lock nut.
3.
CHECK THAT PEDAL FREEPLAY AND PUSH ROD
PLAY ARE CORRECT
Push in on the pedal until the beginning of clutch resistance is
felt.
Pedal freeplay: 5.0 – 15.0 mm (0.197 – 0.591 in.)
Gently push the pedal until the resistance begins to increase a
little.
Push rod play at pedal top:
1.0 – 5.0 mm (0.039 – 0.197 in.)
4.
(a)
Pedal Freeplay
(b)
(c)
(d)
IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PEDAL FREEPLAY AND
PUSH ROD PLAY
Loosen the lock nut and turn the push rod until the freeplay and push rod play are correct.
Tighten the lock nut.
After adjusting the pedal freeplay, check the pedal height.
Connect the air duct and install the lower finish panel.
CL0042
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
25 mm (0.98 in. ) or more
Release
Point
Full Stroke
End Position
CL0512
INSPECT CLUTCH RELEASE POINT
Pull the parking brake lever and install wheel stopper.
Start the engine and idle the engine.
Without depressing the clutch pedal, slowly shift the shift
lever into reverse position until the gears contact.
(d) Gradually depress the clutch pedal and measure the
stroke distance from the point the gear noise stops (release point) up to the full stroke end position.
Standard distance:
25 mm (0.98 in.) or more
(From pedal stroke end position to release point)
If the distance not as specified, do the following operation.
Inspect pedal height.
Inspect push rod play and pedal freeplay.
Bleed the clutch line.
Inspect the clutch cover and disc.
Author:
Date:
1781
CL–3
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH PEDAL
6.
(a)
CHECK CLUTCH START SYSTEM
Check that the engine does not start when the clutch pedal is released.
(b) Check that the engine starts when the clutch pedal is fully
depressed.
If necessary, replace the clutch start switch.
Clutch
Start
Switch
Q00307
5.0 ± 0.5 mm (0.197 ± 0.020 in.)
7.
INSPECT CONTINUITY OF CLUTCH START SWITCH
Check the continuity between terminals when the switch is ON
and OFF.
Switch position
Condition
ON (pushed)
Continuity
OFF (free)
No continuity
CL0477
Author:
Date:
1782
CL–4
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
CL036–01
COMPONENTS
Filler Cap
Clip
Float
Reservoir
Tank
Grommet
Clevis Pin
Boot
Slotted Spring Pin
Washer
Master Cylinder Body
Clevis
Piston
Lock Nut
Clutch Line
Snap Ring
15 (155, 11)
Push Rod
Spring
12 (120, 9)
Non–reusable part
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Q10085
Author:
Date:
1783
CL–5
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
CL037–01
REMOVAL
SST
Q10094
1.
DRAW OUT FLUID WITH SYRINGE
2.
DISCONNECT CLUTCH LINE
Using SST, disconnect the clutch line. Use a container to catch
the fluid.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
3.
REMOVE CLIP AND CLEVIS PIN
4.
REMOVE 2 MOUNTING NUTS AND PULL OUT MASTER CYLINDER
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1784
CL–6
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
CL038–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE RESERVOIR TANK
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin.
Remove the reservoir tank and grommet.
Q10083
2.
REMOVE PUSH ROD
Pull back the boot, and using snap ring pliers, remove the snap
ring.
3.
REMOVE PISTON
Q05039
Author:
Date:
1785
CL–7
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
CL039–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
2.
3.
COAT PARTS WITH LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL
GREASE, AS SHOWN
INSERT PISTON INTO CYLINDER
INSTALL PUSH ROD ASSEMBLY WITH SNAP RING
CL0528
4.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL RESERVOIR TANK
Install the reservoir tank and a new grommet.
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted spring
pin.
Protrusion
1.5 – 3.5 mm
(0.059 – 0.138 in.)
Q10081
Author:
Date:
1786
CL–8
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
CL03A–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page CL–5).
HINT:
After installation, bleed system and adjust clutch pedal (See page CL–2).
Author:
Date:
1787
CL–9
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
CL03B–01
COMPONENTS
Clutch Line
15 (155, 11)
Release Cylinder Body
12 (120, 9)
Piston
Boot
Bleeder Plug
8.4 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
Spring
Push Rod
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Q10016
Author:
Date:
1788
CL–10
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
CL03C–01
REMOVAL
SST
Q10077
1.
DISCONNECT CLUTCH LINE
Using SST, disconnect the line. Use a container to catch the
fluid.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
2.
REMOVE 2 BOLTS AND PULL OUT RELEASE CYLINDER
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1789
CL–11
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
CL03D–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE BLEEDER PLUG
2.
PULL OUT BOOT WITH PUSH ROD
3.
REMOVE PISTON
Blow compressed air into the release cylinder and remove the
piston with spring.
Q05878
Author:
Date:
1790
CL–12
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
CL03E–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
2.
3.
4.
COAT PISTON WITH LITHIUM SOAP BASE GLYCOL
GREASE, AS SHOWN
INSTALL PISTON WITH SPRING INTO CYLINDER
INSTALL BOOT WITH PUSH ROD TO CYLINDER
INSTALL BLEEDER PLUG
Torque: 8.4 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
Q06048
Author:
Date:
1791
CL–13
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
CL03F–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page CL–10).
HINT:
After installation, bleed clutch system.
Author:
Date:
1792
CL–14
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR (1MZ–FE)
CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR (1MZ–FE)
CL03G–01
COMPONENTS
w/ Cruise Control System :
Starter
39 (400, 29)
Cruise Control
Actuator
21 (210, 15)
Battery
27 (270, 20)
13 (130, 9)
13 (130, 9)
Clutch Accumulator Bracket
15 (155, 11)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Q10092
Author:
Date:
1793
CL–15
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR (1MZ–FE)
CL03H–01
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
(b)
w/ Cruise Control System:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Remove the battery.
Remove the 3 bolts and cruise control actuator with
bracket.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Q10074
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE STARTER
Remove the nut and disconnect the connectors.
Remove the 2 bolt and clamp.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
3.
(a)
REMOVE CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR WITH BRACKET
Using SST, disconnect the clutch lines from the clutch accumulator.
Torque: 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
SST 09023–00100
Remove the 2 bolts and nut.
Torque:
Bolt: 21 N·m (210 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
Nut: 27 N·m (270 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
Q10078
SST
Q10076
(b)
Author:
Date:
1794
CL–16
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR (1MZ–FE)
CL03I–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page CL–15).
Author:
Date:
1795
CL–17
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
CLUTCH UNIT
CL03J–01
COMPONENTS
5S–FE :
Release Fork
Flywheel
39 (400, 29)
19 (195, 14)
x6
Release Bearing and Hub
Release Fork
47 (480, 35)
5S–FE :
Clutch Disc
Clutch Cover
Clutch Disc
Boot
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Q10017
Author:
Date:
1796
CL–18
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
CL03K–01
REMOVAL
1.
Matchmarks
Q10161
REMOVE TRANSAXLE FROM ENGINE
(See page E153 MX–4, S51 MX–4)
2.
REMOVE CLUTCH COVER AND DISC
(a) Place matchmarks on the flywheel and clutch cover.
(b) Loosen each set bolt one turn at a time until spring tension
is released.
(c) Remove the set bolts, and pull off the clutch cover with the
clutch disc.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the clutch disc.
3.
1MZ–FE:
(a)
(b)
REMOVE RELEASE BEARING AND FORK FROM
TRANSAXLE
Remove the release bearing together with the fork and
then separate them.
Remove the boot.
5S–FE:
Z19000
Author:
Date:
1797
CL–19
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
CL03L–01
INSPECTION
1MZ–FE:
1.
INSPECT CLUTCH DISC FOR WEAR OR DAMAGE
Using calipers, measure the rivet head depth.
Minimum rivet depth: 0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
If necessary, replace the clutch disc.
5S–FE:
Q10090
2.
INSPECT CLUTCH DISC RUNOUT
Using a dial indicator, check the disc runout.
Maximum runout: 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
If necessary, replace the clutch disc.
CL0373
3.
INSPECT FLYWHEEL RUNOUT
Using a dial indicator, check the flywheel runout.
Maximum runout: 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
If necessary, replace the flywheel.
CL0372
A
4.
INSPECT DIAPHRAGM SPRING FOR WEAR
Using calipers, measure the diaphragm spring for depth and
width of wear.
Maximum:
Depth A: 0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
Width B: 5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
If necessary, replace the clutch cover.
B
Z09915
Author:
Date:
1798
CL–20
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
5.
INSPECT RELEASE BEARING
Turn the bearing by hand while applying force in the axial direction.
HINT:
The bearing is permanently lubricated and requires no cleaning
or lubrication.
If necessary, replace the bearing.
N00414
Author:
Date:
1799
CL–21
CLUTCH
–
CLUTCH UNIT
CL03M–02
INSTALLATION
1MZ–FE:
1.
(a)
(b)
SST
INSTALL CLUTCH DISC AND CLUTCH COVER ON
FLYWHEEL
1MZ–FE:
Insert SST in the clutch disc, and then set them.
SST 09301–00220
5S–FE:
Insert SST in the clutch disc, and then set them.
SST 09301–00210
Flywheel
Side
5S–FE:
SST
Q10089
3
5
(c)
(d)
SST
1
Align the matchmarks on the clutch cover and flywheel.
Torque the bolts on the clutch cover in the order shown.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Temporarily tighten the No.3 bolt.
6
4
2
Matchmarks
Q10084
2.
CHECK DIAPHRAGM SPRING TIP ALIGNMENT
Using a dial indicator with roller instrument, check the diaphragm spring tip alignment.
Maximum non–alignment: 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If alignment is not as specified, using SST, adjust the diaphragm spring tip alignment.
SST 09333–00013
SST
Q10072
Author:
Date:
1800
CL–22
CLUTCH
3.
1MZ–FE Engine:
(a)
(b)
–
CLUTCH UNIT
APPLY MOLYBDENUM DISULPHIDE LITHIUM BASE
GREASE (NLGI NO.2)
Apply release hub grease to these parts:
Release fork and hub contact point
Release fork and push rod contact point
Release fork pivot point
Apply clutch spline grease:
Clutch disc spline
HINT:
Recommended grease part number 08887–01706 (100 g).
4.
INSTALL RELEASE BEARING AND FORK TO TRANSAXLE
Install the bearing to the release fork, and then install them to
the transaxle.
5.
INSTALL TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE
(See page E153 MX–9, S51 MX–8)
5S–FE Engine:
Q10091
Author:
Date:
1801
BE–1
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
BE09Y–01
PRECAUTION
Take care to observe the following precautions when performing inspections or removal and replacement
of body electrical related parts.
1.
HEADLIGHT SYSTEM
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and require special handling. They can burst if scratched
or dropped. Hold a bulb only by its plastic or metal case. Don’t touch the glass part of a bulb with bare
hands.
2.
SRS (SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM)
The CAMRY is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the driver airbag and
front passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service operation in the correct sequence could cause the
SRS to unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident. Before servicing
(including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the precautionary notices in the RS section.
3.
AUDIO SYSTEM
If the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the preset AM, FM 1 and FM 2 stations stored in memory are erased, so make sure to note the stations and reset them after the negative
(–) terminal cable is reconnected to the battery.
If the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the ”ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM” will
operate when the cable is reconnected, but the radio, tape player and CD player will not operate. Be
sure to input the correct ID number so that the radio, tape player and CD player can be operated again.
4.
MOBILE COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to precautions in the IN section.
Author:
Date:
2221
BE–2
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
BE09Z–03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
POWER OUTLET
Symptom
Electric power source cannot be taken out of the power outlet
Suspect Area
See page
11.Battery
12.POWER OUTLET Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
13.Wire Harness
–
–
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM (USA)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight is normal)
1. HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
2. Headlight Bulb
3. Wire Harness
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight does not light up)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Only one side light does not light.
1. HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
2. Headlight Bulb
3. Wire Harness
”Lo–Beam” does not light.
1. Headlight Bulb
2. Light Control Switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–24
–
”Hi–Beam” does not light.
1. Headlight Dimmer Switch
2. Light Control Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–24
BE–24
–
”Flash” does not light.
1. Headlight Dimmer Switch
2. Wire Harness
BE–24
–
”Auto Turn–off System” does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
–
–
BE–14
BE–24
BE–14
–
Taillight does not light. (Headlight does not light)
1. Light Control Switch
2. Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
BE–24
BE–14
–
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight is normal)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
–
BE–24
BE–24
BE–14
–
Only one side light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
Rear Combination light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Light Failure Sensor
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–37
–
”Auto Turn–off System” does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
–
BE–14
BE–32
–
HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Headlight Control Relay (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Headlight Bulb
Wire Harness
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.2)
Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
Ignition Switch
Wire Harness
TAIL Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Taillight Control Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Light Control Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
–
–
–
–
BE–24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
Wire Harness
Author:
Date:
2222
BE–3
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM (CANADA)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight is normal)
1. Wire Harness
–
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight does not light up)
1. Wire Harness
–
Only one side light does not light.
1. Headlight Bulb
2. HEAD LO (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room R/B No.2)
3. Wire Harness
–
–
–
”Lo–Beam” does not light.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Headlight Bulb
HEAD LO (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room R/B No.2)
Headlight Control Relay (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Light Control Switch
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–24
BE–14
BE–24
–
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Headlight Bulb
ECU–B Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
DRL Fuse (E/G Room R/B No.2)
Daytime Running Light Relay No.2
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
6. Daytime Running Light Relay No.3
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
7. Daytime Running Light Relay No.4
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
8. Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
9. Headlight Dimmer Switch
10.Wire Harness
–
–
–
–
–
BE–24
–
BE–24
–
BE–24
BE–24
BE–24
–
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
”Flash” does not light.
Headlight Bulb
ECU–B Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
DRL Fuse (E/G Room R/B No.2)
Daytime Running Light Relay No.2
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
6. Daytime Running Light Relay No.3
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
7. Daytime Running Light Relay No.4
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
8. Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
9. Headlight Dimmer Switch
10.Wire Harness
–
–
–
–
–
BE–24
–
BE–24
–
BE–24
BE–24
BE–24
–
”Auto Turn–off System” does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.2)
Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
Ignition Switch
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–14
BE–24
BE–14
–
Headlight does not light with engine running and light control SW
OFF.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Headlight Bulb
ECU–B Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
Wire Harness
Other Parts*
–
–
–
–
BE–24
–
–
”Hi–Beam” does not light.
Author:
Date:
2223
BE–4
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight does not light)
1. Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Light Control Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–14
BE–24
–
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight is normal)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
–
BE–24
BE–14
BE–24
–
Only one side light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
Rear Combination light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Light Failure Sensor
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–37
–
”Auto Turn–off System” does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
–
BE–14
BE–24
–
TAIL Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Taillight Control Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Light Control Switch
Wire Harness
–
–
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
Wire Harness
*Terminal L of generator and parking brake switch
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
”Hazard” and ”Turn” do not light up.
1. Hazard Warning Switch
2. Turn Signal Flasher
3. Wire Harness
BE–30
BE–30
–
The flashing frequency is abnormal.
1. Bulb
2. Turn Signal Switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–30
–
Hazard warning light does not light up.
(Turn is normal.)
1. HORN Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
2. Wire Harness
Hazard warning light does not light up in one direction.
1. Hazard Warning Switch
2. Wire Harness
BE–30
–
*1Turn signal does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Ignition Switch
TURN Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Turn Signal Switch
Wire Harness
BE–14
–
BE–30
–
*2Turn signal does not light up.
1. TURN Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Turn Signal Switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–30
–
Turn signal does not light up in one direction.
1. Turn Signal Switch
2. Wire Harness
BE–30
–
Only one bulb does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
–
–
*1: Combination meter, wiper and washer do not operate.
*2: Combination meter, wiper and washer are normal.
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
”Illuminated Entry System” does not operate.
1. Door Courtesy Switch
2. Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
Only one interior light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Interior light does not light up (All).
1. DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Author:
BE–32
BE–14
–
Date:
2224
BE–5
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Dome light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Dome Light
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–32
–
Map Light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Map Light
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–32
–
Luggage compartment light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Luggage compartment door courtesy switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–32
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
Symptom
Back–Up Light does not light up.
Back–Up Light remains always ON.
Only one light does not light up.
Suspect Area
1.
2.
3.
4.
See page
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Ignition Switch
Wire Harness
Bulb
1. Back–Up Light Switch (M/T)
2. Park/Neutral Position Switch (A/T)
–
BE–14
–
–
3. Wire Harness
BE–35
DI–424
DI–479
–
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
(A140E)
(A541E)
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Stop light does not light up.
1. STOP Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Stop Light Switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–37
–
Only one light always lights up.
1. Wire Harness
–
Only one light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
*1: Inspect wiper arm and blade set position
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Wiper and washers do not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
WIPER Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Wiper Switch
Wiper Motor
Wire Harness
Wipers do not operate in LO or HI.
1. Wiper Switch
2. Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness
BE–40
BE–40
–
Wipers do not operate in INT.
1. Wiper Switch
2. Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness
BE–40
BE–40
–
Washer motor does not operate.
1. Washer Switch
2. Washer Motor
3. Wire Harness
BE–40
BE–40
–
Wipers do not operate when washer switch in ON.
1. Washer Motor
2. Wire Harness
BE–40
–
Author:
–
BE–40
BE–40
–
Date:
2225
BE–6
BODY ELECTRICAL
Washer fluid does not operate.
In wiper switch HI position, the wiper blade is in contact with
the body.
When the wiper switch is OFF, the wiper blade does not
retract or the retract position is wrong.
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
1. Washer Hose and Nozzle
–
*1Wiper
1.
Switch
2. Wire Harness
BE–40
–
COMBINATION METER
METER, GAUGES AND ILLUMINATION:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Tachometer, Fuel Gauge and Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
do not operate.
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–46
–
Speedometer does not operate.
1. No.1 Vehicle Speed Sensor
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
BE–47
BE–46
–
1. Igniter
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
IG–1
IG–1
BE–46
–
Fuel Gauge does not operate or abnormal operation.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Fuel Receiver Gauge
Fuel Sender Gauge
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
BE–47
BE–47
BE–46
–
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge does not operate or abnormal
operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
Engine Coolant Temperature Receiver Gauge
Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Gauge
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
BE–47
BE–47
BE–46
–
All illumination lights do not light up.
1. TAIL Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Light Control Rheostat
3. Wire Harness
Brightness does not change even when rheostat turned.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Only one illumination light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Tachometer does not operate.
(5S–FE)
(1MZ–FE)
–
BE–47
–
COMBINATION METER
WARNING LIGHTS:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Warning lights do not light up. (Except Discharge, Open Door and
SRS)
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–46
–
Low Oil Pressure warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–46
–
Fuel Level warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Fuel Level Warning Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–46
–
ABS warning light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. ABS ECU
3. Wire Harness
–
IN–31
–
Author:
Date:
2226
BE–7
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–47
–
1.
2.
3.
4.
IGN Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Bulb
Wire Harness
Generator
–
–
–
CH–1
CH–1
Light Failure warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Bulb
Light Failure Sensor
Bulb Check Relay
Wire Harness
Taillight system
–
BE–37
BE–47
–
BE–24
Brake warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Bulb
Parking Brake Switch
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
Bulb Check Relay
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–47
BE–47
BE–46
–
SRS Warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
ECU–B Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Bulb
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
DI–626
BE–46
–
Open Door warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Bulb
Door Courtesy Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–32
BE–46
–
Washer Level warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Washer Fluid Level Warning Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–46
–
Seat Belt warning light does not light up.
Discharge warning light does not light up.
(5S–FE)
(1MZ–FE)
COMBINATION METER
INDICATOR LIGHTS:
Symptom
Suspect Area
1. Bulb
2. O/D OFF Switch
See page
3. Meter Circuit Plate
4. Wire Harness
–
DI–431
DI–487
BE–46
–
Cruise Control indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Cruise Control ECU
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
IN–31
BE–46
–
High beam indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
Headlight System
–
BE–46
–
BE–22
Turn indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning System
–
BE–46
–
BE–29
O/D OFF indicator light does not light up.
Author:
(A140E)
(A541E)
Date:
2227
BE–8
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
4. Wire Harness
–
BE–46
DI–424
DI–479
–
Only one shift indicator does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Meter Circuit Plate
–
BE–46
Malfunction indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
ECM
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–46
–
SLIP indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Traction ECU
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–46
–
TRAC OFF indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Traction ECU
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–46
–
Security indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Security ECU
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–46
–
Indicator lights do not light up. (Except Turn, Hi–beam and
security)
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Wire Harness
Shift indicator lights do not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Park/Neutral Position Switch
(A140E)
(A541E)
–
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
All defogger systems do not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DEFOG M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
HTR Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Defogger Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Defogger Switch
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–56
BE–56
–
Rear window defogger does not operate.
1. Defogger Wire
2. Choke Coil
3. Wire Harness
BE–56
–
–
Mirror defogger does not operate.
1. MIR/HTR Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Mirror Defogger
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–56
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Power window does not operate (ALL).
(Power Door Lock does not operate)
1. POWER M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Power Main Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–60
–
Power window does not operate (ALL).
(Power Door Lock is normal)
1. Ignition Switch
2. Power Window Master Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–14
BE–60
–
”One Touch Power Window System” does not operate.
1. Power Window Master Switch
BE–60
Only one window glass does not move.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Power Window Master Switch
Power Window Switch
Power Window Motor
Wire Harness
BE–60
BE–60
BE–60
–
”Window Lock System” does not operate.
1. Power Window Master Switch
BE–60
Author:
Date:
2228
BE–9
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
”Window Lock Illumination” does not light up.
1. Power Window Master Switch
BE–60
Key–off power window does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
–
BE–60
BE–14
BE–32
–
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Ignition Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Wire Harness
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
”Door lock system” does not operate at all.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
POWER M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
CIG Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
DOOR Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
–
–
–
BE–70
–
Door lock system does not operate by manual switch.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Power Window Master Switch
Door Lock Manual Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
BE–60
BE–70
BE–70
–
Door lock system does not operate by door key.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
Door Lock Link Disconnected
BE–70
BE–70
–
–
Fault in 2–Operation unlock function of Driver’s side door key lock
and unlock switch.
1. Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
2. Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
BE–70
BE–70
–
Fault in key confine prevention operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
BE–70
BE–14
BE–32
–
Only one door lock does not operate.
1. Door Lock Motor
2. Wire Harness
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Key Unlock Warning Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Wire Harness
BE–70
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Sliding roof system does not operate.
(Door Lock does not operate)
1. POWER M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Power Main Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–60
–
Sliding roof system does not operate.
(Door Lock is normal)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Ignition Switch
Sliding Roof Control Relay and Switch
Sliding Roof Motor and Limit Switch
Wire Harness
BE–14
BE–74
BE–74
–
Sliding roof system operates abnormally.
1. Sliding Roof Control Relay and Switch
2. Sliding Roof Motor and Limit Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–74
BE–74
–
Sliding roof system stops operation half way.
(Stones of foreign material trapped in motor assembly)
1. Sliding Roof Control Relay and Switch
2. Sliding Roof Motor and Limit Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–74
BE–74
–
”Key–off Sliding Roof” operation does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
–
–
BE–14
BE–14
–
DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Ignition Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
Author:
Date:
2229
BE–10
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Power seat does not operate.
(Door lock system does not operate)
1. POWER M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Power seat does not operate.
(Door lock system is normal)
1. Power Seat Swtich (D,P)
2. Wire Harness
BE–78
–
”Slide operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch (D, P)
2. Wire Harness
3. Slide Motor (D, P)
BE–78
–
BE–78
”Lifter Operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch (D, P)
2. Wire Harness
3. Lifter Motor (D, P)
BE–78
–
BE–78
”Reclining Operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch (D, P)
2. Wire Harness
3. Reclining Motor (D, P)
BE–78
–
BE–78
(D): Driver’s seat
(P): Passenger’s seat
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
Mirror does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Mirror operates abnormally.
1. Mirror Switch
2. Mirror Motor
3. Wire Harness
See page
CIG Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Mirror Switch
Mirror Motor
Wire Harness
–
BE–83
BE–83
–
BE–83
BE–83
–
Author:
Date:
2230
BE–11
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER SOURCE
POWER SOURCE
BE0A0–03
LOCATION
Engine Room Relay Block No.1
Engine Room Junction
Block No.2
Engine Room Relay Block No.2
Instrument Panel Junction Block No.1
Turn Signal Flasher
Z19043
Author:
Date:
2231
BE–12
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER OUTLET
POWER OUTLET
BE0A1–03
LOCATION
Power Outlet
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
PWR OUTLET Fuse
N20688
Author:
Date:
2232
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
BE–13
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
BE0A2–03
LOCATION
Key Unlock Warning Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
Integration Relay
Ignition Switch
N20687
Author:
Date:
2233
BE–14
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
BE0A3–02
INSPECTION
1.
ACC
ON
LOCK
4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5
START
N14824
INSPECT IGNITION SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
LOCK
–
ACC
2–3
Continuity
ON
2–3–4
6–7
Continuity
START
1–2–4
6–7–8
Continuity
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
OFF
ON
2 1
INSPECT KEY UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
OFF (Key removed)
–
ON (Key set)
1–2
Specified condition
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20125
3.
10
6
5
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
Key unlock warning system:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE A) OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminals 5, 6 and 10.
Check the buzzer sounds.
N20126
(d)
10
6
5
(e)
1
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 6.
Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
N20127
Author:
Date:
2234
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
BE–15
(f)
10 6
5
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
6.
(g) Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 5.
(h) Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
1
N20128
4.
10
6
5
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
Key unlock warning system:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE B) OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminals 5, 6 and 10.
Check the buzzerr sounds.
N20129
(d)
10
6
5
(e)
1
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 6.
Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
N20130
(f)
10
6
5
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
6.
(g) Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 5.
(h) Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
1
N20131
5.
10
6
5
(a)
1
(b)
(c)
Key unlock warning system:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE C) OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminals 5, 6 and 10.
Check the buzzerr sounds.
N20132
Author:
Date:
2235
BE–16
BODY ELECTRICAL
(d)
(e)
10
6
5
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 6.
Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
1
N20133
(f)
10
6
5
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
6.
(g) Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 5.
(h) Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
1
N20134
6.
(a)
Junction block side:
12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE A) CIRCUIT
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and inspect the connector on the junction block side.
3 2 1
N20135
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 – Ground
4 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
2 – Ground
4 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch OFF
No continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch ON
Continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch OFF
No continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch ON
Continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch OFF (Seat belt unfastened)
No continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch ON (Seat belt fastened)
Continuity
10 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
Author:
Date:
2236
BODY ELECTRICAL
(b)
Wire harness side:
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
BE–17
Disconnect the connector from the integration relay and
inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
1 23 4
N20136
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 – Ground
Light control switch OFF
No continuity
1 – Ground
Light control switch HEAD or TAIL
Continuity
4 – Ground
Light control switch OFF or TAIL
No continuity
4 – Ground
Light control switch HEAD
Continuity
2 – Ground
3 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
If the circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new
one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
7.
(a)
Junction block side:
12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE B) CIRCUIT
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and inspect the connector on the junction block side.
3 2 1
N20135
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 – Ground
All door courtesy switches OFF (Except Driver’s
Door/ Door closed)
No continuity
2 – Ground
One of the door courtesy switches ON (Except
Driver’s Door/ Door opened)
Continuity
4 – Ground
Door courtesy switches except that of the driver’s
door OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
4 – Ground
One of the door courtesy switches except that of
the driver’s door ON (Door opened)
Continuity
Author:
Date:
2237
BE–18
BODY ELECTRICAL
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch OFF
No continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch ON
Continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch ON (Door opened)
Continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch OFF (Seat belt unfastened)
No continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch ON (Seat belt fastened)
Continuity
10 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
11 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK
No voltage
11 – Ground
Ignition switch ACC or ON
Battery positive voltage
(b)
Wire harness side:
1
–
2 3 4 5 6
Disconnect the connector from the integration relay and
inspect the connectors on the wire harness side.
7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
Connector ”A”
Wire harness side:
1 2 3
eh–25–1
h–4–1
4
Connector ”B”
N20137
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A3 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
A5 – Ground
Driver’s door unlock detection switch OFF (Door
locked)
No continuity
A5 – Ground
Driver’s door unlock detection switch ON (Door
unlocked)
Continuity
A6 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
Author:
Date:
2238
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
A6 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
A7 – Ground
Passenger’s door unlock detection switch OFF
(Door locked)
No continuity
A7 – Ground
Passenger’s door unlock detection switch ON
(Door unlocked)
Continuity
A9 – Ground
Rear door unlock detection switch OFF (Door
locked)
No continuity
A9 – Ground
Rear door unlock detection switch ON (Door
unlocked)
Continuity
Constant
Continuity
A16 – Ground
Door lock manual switch OFF or UNLOCK
No continuity
A16 – Ground
Door lock manual switch LOCK
Continuity
A17 – Ground
Door lock manual switch OFF or LOCK
No continuity
A17 – Ground
Door lock manual switch UNLOCK
Continuity
A18 – Ground
Driver’s and passenger’s door key lock and
unlock switch OFF or UNLOCK
No continuity
A18 – Ground
Driver’s or passenger’s door key lock and unlock
switch LOCK
Continuity
A19 – Ground
Driver’s door key lock and unlock switch OFF or
LOCK
No continuity
A19 – Ground
Driver’s door key lock and unlock switch
UNLOCK
Continuity
A20 – Ground
Passenger’s door key lock and unlock switch
OFF or LOCK
No continuity
A20 – Ground
Passenger’s door key lock and unlock switch
UNLOCK
Continuity
A1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
B1 – Ground
Light control switch OFF
No voltage
B1 – Ground
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
Battery positive voltage
B4 – Ground
Light control switch OFF or TAIL
No voltage
B4 – Ground
Light control switch HEAD
Battery positive voltage
B2 – Ground
B3 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
A11 – A12
A12 – A25
BE–19
If the circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new
one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
8.
(a)
Junction block side:
12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE C) CIRCUIT
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and inspect the connector on the junction block side.
3 2 1
N20135
Author:
Date:
2239
BE–20
BODY ELECTRICAL
Tester connection
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
Condition
Specified condition
2 – Ground
All door courtesy switches OFF (Except Driver’s
Door/ Door closed)
No continuity
2 – Ground
One of the door courtesy switches ON (Except
Driver’s Door/ Door opened)
Continuity
4 – Ground
Door courtesy switches except that of the driver’s
door OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
4 – Ground
One of the door courtesy switches except that of
the driver’s door ON (Door opened)
Continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch OFF
No continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch ON
Continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch ON (Door opened)
Continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch OFF (Seat belt unfastened)
No continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch ON (Seat belt fastened)
Continuity
10 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
11 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK
No voltage
11 – Ground
Ignition switch ACC or ON
Battery positive voltage
(b)
Wire harness side:
Disconnect the connector from the integration relay and
inspect the connectors on the wire harness side.
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Connector ”A”
Wire harness side:
1 2 3 4
Connector ”B”
N20138
Author:
Date:
2240
BODY ELECTRICAL
Tester connection
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
Condition
Specified condition
A1 – Ground
Door lock manual switch OFF or UNLOCK
No continuity
A1 – Ground
Door lock manual switch LOCK
Continuity
A2 – Ground
Door lock manual switch OFF or LOCK
No continuity
A2 – Ground
Door lock manual switch UNLOCK
Continuity
A3 – Ground
Driver’s and passenger’s door key lock and
unlock switch OFF or UNLOCK
No continuity
A3 – Ground
Driver’s or passenger’s door key lock and unlock
switch LOCK
Continuity
A4 – Ground
Driver’s door key lock and unlock switch OFF or
LOCK
No continuity
A4 – Ground
Driver’s door key lock and unlock switch
UNLOCK
Continuity
A5 – Ground
Passenger’s door key lock and unlock switch
OFF or LOCK
No continuity
A5 – Ground
Passenger’s door key lock and unlock switch
UNLOCK
Continuity
Constant
Continuity
A8 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
A8 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
A9 – Ground
Driver’s door unlock detection switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
A9 – Ground
Driver’s door unlock detection switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
A10 – Ground
Passenger’s door unlock detection switch OFF
(Door closed)
No continuity
A10 – Ground
Passenger’s door unlock detection switch ON
(Door opened)
Continuity
A11 – Ground
Rear door unlock detection switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
A11 – Ground
Rear door unlock detection switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
A12 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
A13 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
B1 – Ground
Light control switch OFF
No voltage
B1 – Ground
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
Battery positive voltage
B4 – Ground
Light control switch OFF or TAIL
No voltage
B4 – Ground
Light control switch HEAD
Battery positive voltage
B2 – Ground
B3 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
A6 – A7
BE–21
If the circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new
one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
Author:
Date:
2241
BE–22
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE0A4–02
LOCATION
E/G Room J/B No.2
HEAD LH Fuse (USA)
HEAD RH Fuse (USA)
HEAD LH (UPR) Fuse (CANADA)
HEAD RH (UPR) Fuse (CANADA)
DOME Fuse
ECU–B Fuse
Headlight Control Relay
Daytime Resister
E/G Room R/B No.2 (CANADA)
HEAD LH (LWR) Fuse
HEAD RH (LWR) Fuse
DRL No.2 Fuse
Daytime Running Light Relay No.4
Automatic Light
Control Sensor
Headlight
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
GAUGE Fuse
TAIL Fuse
Taillight Control Relay
Integration Relay
Ignition Switch
Combination Switch
Light Control Switch
Headlight Dimmer Switch
Daytime Running
Light Relay
Door Courtesy Switch
Light Failure Sensor
Taillight
I08436
Author:
Date:
2242
BE–23
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE0A5–02
COMPONENTS
Combination Switch
Light Control Switch
Headlight Dimmer Switch
Switch Body
Spiral Cable
Combination Switch
Wiper and Washer Switch
N18012
Author:
Date:
2243
BE–24
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE10D–01
INSPECTION
1.
Hi beam
HEAD
TAIL
OFF
Flash
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
–
TAIL
14 – 16
Continuity
HEAD
13 – 14 – 16
Continuity
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH CONTINUITY
8 7
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Low beam
16 – 17
Continuity
High beam
7 – 16
Continuity
Flash
7 – 8 – 16
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
17
16
14 13
N20149
3.
1
2
4
2
1
4
3
3
INSPECT HEADLIGHT CONTROL RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Z08521
4.
2
1
3
5
5
2
1
3
INSPECT TAILLIGHT CONTROL RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
N14863
5.
2
4
1
3
2
4
1
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1 – 4, 2 – 4
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 2 and 4.
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
3
Z08523
Author:
Date:
2244
BE–25
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
6.
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
Wire harness side:
I08219
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 – Ground
Light control switch position OFF or TAIL
No continuity
2 – Ground
Light control switch position HEAD
Continuity
3 – Ground
Headlight dimmer switch position
Low beam
No continuity
3 – Ground
Headlight dimmer switch position
High beam of Flash
Continuity
4 – Ground
Brake fluid level warning position OFF
No continuity
4 – Ground
Brake fluid level warning position ON
Continuity
12 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
14 – Ground
Parking brake switch position OFF
(Parking brake lever released)
No continuity
14 – Ground
Parking brake switch position ON
(Parking brake lever pulled up)
Continuity
17 – Ground
Light control switch position OFF or HEAD
No voltage
17 – Ground
Light control switch position TAIL
Continuity
20 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
21 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
13 – Ground
Engine Stop
No voltage
13 – Ground
Engine Running
Battery positive voltage
16 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
18 – Ground
Ground terminal 19
Battery positive voltage
19 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
22 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
23 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
No voltage
23 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON or START
Battery positive voltage
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new one.
If circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
Author:
Date:
2245
BE–26
BODY ELECTRICAL
7.
2
3
1
4
2
1
3
4
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT NO.4 RELAY
CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
3–4
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 3 and 4.
1–2
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Z08559
8.
2 1
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RESISTER CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Approx. 250mΩ
If continuity is not as specified, replace the resistor.
9.
INSPECT LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF SYSTEM
(See Integration relay circuit on page BE–14)
N20139
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the light control switch to OFF.
Parking brake lever released.
Gradually cover the top of the sensor.
Verify that the lights should turn ON the accessory lights
and the headlights.
11.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL
Gradually expose the sensor.
Verify that the lights should turn OFF the headlights and
the accessory lights.
INSPECT LIGHT–OFF CONDITION
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Gradually cover the top of the sensor.
Lights auto ON:
INSPECT LIGHTS–ON CONDITION
Open the driver’s door while the ignition switch is OFF.
Turn the light control switch to OFF leaving the door open
and cover the top of the sensor, and verify that the lights
go on when the ignition switch is turned ON.
I08422
12.
(a)
(b)
I08423
13.
(a)
(b)
Author:
Date:
2246
BE–27
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
14.
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
CIRCUIT
Connector disconnected:
Disconnect the connector from the sensor and inspect the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in the table.
Wire harness side:
1234
I01254
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3 – Ground
Constant
Constant
1 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
1 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
5.2 – 9.0 v
If circuit is as specified, perform the inspection on the following
page.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuit connected to
other parts.
15.
4
3
1
2
I01255
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
CIRCUIT
Connector disconnected:
Connect the wire harness side connector to the sensor and inspect wire harness side connector from the back side, as
shown.
HINT:
Ignition switch ON.
Light control switch OFF.
Vehicle’s surroundings are bright.
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
1 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
9.5 V or more
Vehicle under the direct sun light.
(Sensor is not covered)
Taillight and Headlight are ON.
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the sensor with a new one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuit connected to
other parts.
Author:
Date:
2247
BE–28
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE0A7–02
ADJUSTMENT
1.
ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIMING
For Adjustment
in Vertical Direction
For Adjustment in
Horizontal Direction
N20156
2.
ADJUST SPIRAL CABLE
(See page SR–16)
Author:
Date:
2248
BE–29
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
BE0A8–03
LOCATION
E/G Room J/B No.2
HORN Fuse
Hazard Warning Switch
Ignition Switch
Turn Signal Light
Instrument Panel J/B
No.1
TURN Fuse
Turn Signal Flasher
Combination Switch
Turn Signal Switch
Turn Signal Light
Z19045
Author:
Date:
2249
BE–30
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
BE0A9–02
INSPECTION
Right
1.
Left
INSPECT TURN SIGNAL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Left turn
1–2
Neutral
–
Right turn
2–3
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
3
2
1
N20150
2.
(a)
3
2
(b)
1
Turn Signal Light Bulbs (21 W)
4 3
BE1843
INSPECT TURN SIGNAL FLASHER OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 3.
Connect the 2 turn signal light bulbs in parallel to each
other to terminals 1 and 3, check that the bulbs flash.
HINT:
The turn signal lights should flash 60 to 120 times per minute.
If one of the front or rear turn signal lights has an open circuit,
the number of flashes will be more than 140 per minute.
If operation is not as specified, replace the flasher.
3.
INSPECT HAZARD WARNING SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Switch OFF
7 – 10
Continuity
Switch ON
5–6–9
7–8
Continuity
Illumination circuit
2–3
Continuity
2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5
Specified condition
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20140
Author:
Date:
2250
BE–31
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AA–03
LOCATION
E/G Room J/B No.2
DOME Fuse
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
Integration Relay
Map Light
Dome Light
Door Courtesy Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Luggage Compartment
Door Courtesy Switch
Z19046
Author:
Date:
2251
BE–32
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AB–03
INSPECTION
w/ Sliding roof:
2
1
1.
INSPECT MAP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
OFF
–
ON
1–2
Specified condition
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the light assembly or
bulb.
w/o Sliding roof:
1
2
N21873
2.
(a)
(b)
2
Ohmmeter
INSPECT DOME LAMP SWITCH
Disconnect the connector from the dome lamp.
Turn the dome lamp switch ON, check that continuity exists between terminal 2 and body ground.
N20157
(c)
Turn the dome lamp switch DOOR, check that there is
continuity exists between terminal 1 and 2.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
2
Ohmmeter
1
N20158
3.
(a)
ON
Ohmmeter
OFF
INSPECT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH CONTINUITY
Check that continuity exists between terminal and the
switch body with the switch ON (switch pin released:
opened door).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between terminal and the
switch body with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed in:
closed doors).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20159
Author:
Date:
2252
BE–33
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
4.
ON
OFF
I01447
INSPECT LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Check that continuity exists between terminal and switch
body with the switch ON (switch pin released: opened
door).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between the terminal and
switch body with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed in:
closed door).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
5.
INSPECT ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM
(See Integration relay circuit on page BE–14)
Author:
Date:
2253
BE–34
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AC–02
LOCATION
Instrument Panel
J/B No.1
GAUGE Fuse
Ignition Switch
Back–up Light
1MZ–FE engine:
5S–FE engine:
Back–up Light
Switch
Back–up Light Switch
PNP Switch
Z19047
Author:
Date:
2254
BE–35
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AD–02
INSPECTION
INSPECT BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Tester connection
Free
–
Push
1–2
Specified condition
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Push
Free
Condition
N14065
Author:
Date:
2255
BE–36
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AE–02
LOCATION
Stop Light Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
STOP Fuse
Hi–Mounted Stop Light
Stop Light
Light Failure Sensor
Z19048
Author:
Date:
2256
BE–37
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AF–02
INSPECTION
w/o Cruise control:
Free
1.
Pushed in
2
1
w/ Cruise control:
Free
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Switch pin free
1–2
Continuity
Switch pin pushed in
1–2
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
w/ Cruise control:
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Pushed in
1
2
w/o Cruise control:
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Switch pin free
1–2
Continuity
Switch pin pushed in
1–2
No continuity
Switch pin free
3–4
No continuity
Switch pin pushed in
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
3
4
N18026
3.
1
INSPECT HI–MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
CONTINUITY
Using the ohmmeter, check that continuity exists between terminals.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the bulb or light assembly.
2
N20208
Author:
Date:
2257
BE–38
BODY ELECTRICAL
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
4.
INSPECT LIGHT FAILURE RELAY CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect the connector on the wire harness side, as shown.
Wire harness side:
5 4
–
3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6
e–12–2–B
N20209
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 – Ground
Constant
Continuity*
2 – Ground
Constant
Continuity*
9 – Ground
Constant
Continuity*
11 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
3 – Ground
Light control switch OFF
No voltage
3 – Ground
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
Battery positive voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
7 – Ground
Stop light switch OFF
No voltage
7 – Ground
Stop light switch ON
Battery positive voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
*: There is resistance because this circuit is grounded through
the bulb.
If the circuit is as specified, replace the relay.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
Author:
Date:
2258
BE–39
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
BE0AG–03
LOCATION
Wiper Motor
Washer Tank
Washer Motor
Wiper and Washer Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
WIPER Fuse
Z19049
Author:
Date:
2259
BE–40
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
BE0AH–03
w/o Timer
OFF
INT
LO
HI
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH
CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
OFF
7 – 16
Continuity
INT
7 – 16
Continuity
LO
7 – 17
Continuity
HI
8 – 17
Continuity
Washer ON
2 – 11
Continuity
Washer ON
w/ Timer
OFF
INT
LO
HI
Specified condition
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Washer ON
8 7
17
2
11
16
N20218
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2
7
(d)
16
INSPECT INTERMITTENT OPERATION
Turn the wiper switch to INT position.
Turn the intermittent time control switch to FAST position.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
16 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal 7 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that
the meter needle indicates battery positive voltage.
N20210
(e)
7
2
After connecting terminal 16 to terminal 17, connect it to
terminal 2, check the voltage rises from 0 volts to battery
positive voltage within the time, as shown in the table.
17
INT time control
switch position
16
Voltage
Approx. 2 sec.
Battery positive voltage
FAST
N20211
0V
10.7 ± 5 sec.
Battery positive voltage
SLOW
0V
3.3 ± 1 sec.
Non variable type
Battery positive voltage
0V
If operation is not as specified, replace the wiper and washer
switch.
Author:
Date:
2260
BE–41
BODY ELECTRICAL
3.
(a)
2
7
(b)
(c)
16
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
INSPECT WASHER LINKED OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
16 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal 7 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Push in the washer switch, and check that the voltage
changes as shown in the chart.
Washer Switch ON
N20210
OFF
Less than 1 sec.
Approx. 3 sec.
Battery positive
Voltage
0V
N11301
If operation is not as specified, replace the wiper and washer
switch.
4.
Low speed:
INSPECT FRONT WIPER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 5 and
the negative (–) lead to terminal 4, check that the motor operates at low speed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
5
4
N20151
Author:
Date:
2261
BE–42
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
5.
High speed:
INSPECT FRONT WIPER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 3 and
the negative (–) lead to terminal 4, check that the motor operates at high speed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
3
4
N20152
6.
(a)
Stopping in stop position:
INSPECT FRONT WIPER MOTOR OPERATION
Operate the motor at low speed and stop the motor operation anywhere except in the stop position by disconnecting positive (+) lead from terminal 5.
5
4
N20153
Author:
Date:
2262
BE–43
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
(b)
(c)
3
Connect terminals 3 and 5.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and negative (–) lead to terminal 4, check that the motor
stops running in the stop position after the motor operates
again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
2
5
4
N20154
7.
INSPECT WASHER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 2 and
the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the motor operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be performed quickly (within 20 seconds)
to prevent the coil from burning out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
2
1
2
1
N20155
Author:
Date:
2263
BE–44
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
COMBINATION METER
BE0AI–03
LOCATION
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
E/G Room J/B No.2
ECU–B Fuse
DOME Fuse
Washer Fluid Level
Warning Switch
Combination Meter
Bulb Check Relay
ECM
ABS ECU
Light Control Rheostat
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
GAUGE Fuse
TAIL Fuse
IGN Fuse
Integration Relay
Z19050
Author:
Date:
2264
BE–45
BODY ELECTRICAL
PKB Switch
–
COMBINATION METER
Door Courtesy Switch
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Fuel Sender Gauge
Fuel Level Warning Switch
Light Failure Sensor
5S–FE engine:
1MZ–FE engine:
Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Engine Coolant
Temperature Gauge
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
Low Oil Pressure
Warning Switch
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Z19055
Author:
Date:
2265
BE–46
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
BE0AJ–03
CIRCUIT
Connector ”A”
1 2 3 4 5 6
Connector ”B”
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Connector ”C”
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
J–13–1–A
C7
E
T
7 8 9 10 11 1213
J–16–1
B3
C5
A2
A1
C8
F
1 2 3 4 5 6
Connector ”C”
Connector ”B”
J–13–1
Connector ”A”
B15
C6
S
B14
ODOMETER
Fuel Level Warning
Seat Belt Warning
ABS Warning
Low Oil Pressure Warning
Cruise Control Indicator
Malfunction Indicator
O/D OFF Indicator
Light Failure Warning
Brake Warning
SLIP Indicator
TRAC Indicator
Washer Level Warning
Discharge Warning
A13
B2
C1
B1
C9
A6
A11
A7
A10
A8
A9
Bulb Check
Relay
Right Turn Indicator
Left Turn Indicator
Security Indicator
L
2
D
N
R
P
Illumination
C13
B8
B11
B12
Hi–Beam Indicator
Open Door Warning
SRS Warning
B6
A4
C4
B5
C10
C2
A12
A3
B7
C3
A5
C11
B4
No.
A
B16
B
C12
B9
B10
B13
C
F : Fuel Gauge
E : Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
T : Tachometer
S : Speedometer
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Wire Harness Side
Engine coolant temperature sender gauge
Ground
Light failure sensor
Integration relay
Traction ECU
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
O/D OFF switch (A/T)
IGN fuse
Turn signal switch
ST relay
Fuel sender gauge
Generator
Oil pressure switch
Fuel sender gauge
Parking brake switch and brake fluid level warning switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Door courtesy switch
DOME fuse
ECU–B fuse
Airbag sensor assembly
ECM
No.1 Vehicle speed sensor
Ground
Turn signal switch
ECM
Traction ECU
ABS ECU
Ground
No.1 Vehicle speed sensor
GAUGE fuse
Igniter
Security ECU
Cruise control ECU
Washer fluid level warning switch
Light control rheostat
TAIL fuse
N20107 N20108
Z18937
Author:
Date:
2266
BE–47
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
BE0AK–03
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SPEEDOMETER ON–VEHICLE
Using a speedometer tester, inspect the speedometer for allowable indication error and check the operation of the odometer.
HINT:
Tire wear and tire over or under inflation will increase the indication error.
If error is excessive, replace the speedometer.
USA (mph)
CANADA (km/h)
Standard indication
Allowable range
Standard indication
Allowable range
20
18 – 24
20
40
38 – 44
40
38 – 46
60
56 – 66
60
57.5 – 67
80
78 – 88
80
77 – 88
100
98 – 110
100
96 – 109
120
118 – 132
120
115 – 130
140
134 – 151.5
160
153 – 173
2.
(a)
3
(b)
1
(c)
(d)
2
N02332
17 – 24
INSPECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the tester to terminal
3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Rotate the shaft.
Check that there is voltage change from approx. 0 V to
11 V or more between terminals 2 and 3.
HINT:
The voltage change should be performed 4 times for every revolution of the speed sensor shaft.
If operation is not as specified, replace the sensor.
3.
INSPECT TACHOMETER ON–VEHICLE
(a) Connect a tune–up test tachometer, and start the engine.
NOTICE:
Reversing the connection of the tachometer will damage the transistors and diodes inside.
When removing or installing the tachometer, be careful not to drop or subject it to heavy shocks.
Author:
Date:
2267
BE–48
BODY ELECTRICAL
(b)
Ignition
Switch
–
COMBINATION METER
Compare the tester with tachometer indications.
DC 13.5 V 25°C at (77 °F)
Standard indication
Allowable range
700
630 – 770
1,000
900 – 1,100
2,000
1,850 – 2,150
3,000
2,800 – 3,200
4,000
3,800 – 4,200
5,000
4,800 – 5,200
6,000
5,750 – 6,250
7,000
6,700 – 7,300
4.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the receiver gauge
needle indicates EMPTY.
(c)
Connect terminals 2 and 3 on the wire harness side connector through a 3.4–W test bulb.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the bulb lights up
and the receiver gauge needle moves towards the full
side.
Fuel
Gauge
Battery
N20160
Ignition
Switch
(d)
Fuel
Gauge
Battery
1
2
4
BE1206 Ie–5–1–A
3
5
Z05727
HINT:
Because of the silicon oil in the gauge, it will take a short time
for needle to stabilize.
If operation is not as specified, inspect the receiver gauge resistance.
5.
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
A
B
C
Tester connection
Resistance (Ω)
A–B
Approx. 126.2
A–C
Approx. 280.5
B–C
Approx. 154.3
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver
gauge.
N20212
Author:
Date:
2268
BE–49
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
6.
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals 2 and 3 for each
float position.
F
1/2
E 3
1
2
N20161
Float position mm (in.)
Resistance (Ω)
F: Approx. –91.1 (–3.587)
Approx. 3.0
1/2: Approx. –34.2 (–1.346)
Approx. 31.7
E: Approx. 30.8 (1.213)
Approx. 110.0
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the sender
gauge.
7.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Connect terminals 1 and 3 on the wire harness side connector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the warning light
lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or inspect wire
harness.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
2
1
4
3
5
Z05730
BE1217 Ie–5–1–A
3
1
8.
(a)
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 1 and 3
through a 3.4–W test bulb, check that the bulb lights up.
HINT:
It takes a short time for the bulb to light up.
N20213
1
3
(b) Submerge the switch in fuel, check that the bulb goes out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the sender gauge.
N20214
9.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
Ignition
Switch
Battery
(a)
(b)
Sender
Gauge
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the receiver
gauge needle indicates COOL.
N20215
Author:
Date:
2269
BE–50
BODY ELECTRICAL
Battery
COMBINATION METER
(c)
Ground terminal on the wire harness side connector
through a 3.4–W test bulb.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON, and check that the bulb lights
up and the receiver gauge needle moves to the hot side.
If operation is as specified, replace the sender gauge.
Then, recheck the system.
If operation is not as specified, measure the receiver gauge resistance.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
Ignition
Switch
–
Test Bulb
(3.4 W)
Wire Harness Side
Z15788
10.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
C
B
A
N20216
Tester connection
Resistance (Ω) *
A–B
Approx. 175.7
A–C
Approx. 54.0
B–C
Approx. 229.7
*: This circuit includes the diode.
HINT:
Connect the test leads so that the current from the ohmmeter
can flow according to the above order.
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver
gauge.
11.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between the terminal and gauge body.
Temperature °C (°F)
Resistance (Ω)
50 (122.0)
274
120 (248.0)
26.4
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the engine coolant temperature sender gauge.
N21646
12.
(a)
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the warning switch and
ground terminal on the wire harness side connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
1
Z14205
Author:
Date:
2270
BE–51
BODY ELECTRICAL
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N06640
–
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Disconnect the connector from the switch.
Check that continuity exists between terminal and ground
with the engine stopped.
Check that no continuity exists between terminal and
ground with the engine running.
HINT:
Oil pressure should be over 24.5 kPa (0.25 kgf/cm2, 3.55 psi).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
14.
(a)
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
BE1217
INSPECT BRAKE SYSTEM WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the brake fluid warning
switch.
(b) Release the parking brake pedal.
(c) Connect the terminals on the wire harness side of the level warning switch connector.
(d) Start the engine, check that the warning light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or wire harness.
15.
(a)
(b)
(c)
OFF
ON
2 1
N02346
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
Disconnect the connector.
Check that no continuity exists between the terminals with
the switch OFF (float up).
(d) Use syphon, etc. to take fluid out of the reservoir tank.
(e) Check that continuity exists between the terminals with
the switch ON (float down).
(f)
Pour the fluid back in the reservoir tank.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
16. INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
(a) Check that continuity exists between the terminal and
switch body with the switch ON (switch pin released).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between the terminal and
switch body with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed in).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch or inspect
ground point.
N01212
17.
(a)
INSPECT WASHER FLUID LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connectors from the level warning switch
and parking brake switch.
(b) Connect terminals on the wire harness side connector of
the level warning switch connector.
(c) Remove the GAUGE fuse and turn the ignition switch ON,
and check that the warning light comes on.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
BE1217
Author:
Date:
2271
BE–52
BODY ELECTRICAL
Ohmmeter
OFF
ON
–
COMBINATION METER
18.
(a)
INSPECT WASHER FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
Check that no continuity exists between terminals with the
switch OFF (float up).
(b) Check that continuity exists between terminals with the
switch ON (float down).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20217
19. INSPECT OPEN DOOR WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the door courtesy switch and
ground terminal 1 on the wire harness side, and check that the
warning light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, inspect the bulb or wire harness.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
1
Z05732
20.
(a)
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
BE0044
INSPECT SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
Remove the integration relay from the instrument panel
junction block.
(b) Ground terminal 2 on the integration relay with the connectors still connected.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, inspect the bulb or wire harness.
21.
1
2
OFF
ON
w/o Power seat:
INSPECT BUCKLE SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Check that continuity exists between the terminals on the
switch side connector with the switch ON (belt fastened).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between the terminals on
the switch side connector with the switch OFF (belt unfastened).
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt inner belt.
Z16167
OFF
1
2
ON
N02354
22.
w/ Power seat:
INSPECT BUCKLE SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Check that continuity exists between terminals 1 and 2 on
the switch side connector with the switch ON (belt fastened).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between terminals 1 and
2 on the switch side connector with the switch OFF (belt
unfastened).
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt inner belt.
Author:
Date:
2272
BE–53
BODY ELECTRICAL
23.
Type A:
1
7
(a)
9 10
(b)
(c)
(d)
Type B and C:
1
(e)
7
9
–
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY OF SEAT BELT
WARNING SYSTEM OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminals
1 and 7.
Connect the terminal 7 to terminal 9 through the 3.4–W
test bulb.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
10.
Check that the bulb lights and the buzzer sounds for 4 –
8 seconds.
Return to step (a) and operate the chime again.
10
N20219
(f)
Type A:
1
7
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
8.
Check that the buzzer stops sounding.
(g)
HINT:
Check the buzzer within a period of 4 to 8 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
24. INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY CIRCUIT
See page BE–14
8 9 10
Type B and C:
1
7
8
9
10
N20220
Author:
Date:
2273
BE–54
BODY ELECTRICAL
25.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and negative lead (–) to terminal 3.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal 2 and negative lead to terminal 3.
Turn the rheostat knob and check that the voltage
changes.
270°
2
3
1
N08958
(a)
B
A
C
(b)
B
A
C
26.
(a)
INSPECT BULB CHECK RELAY OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
C through a 1.4–W test bulb and the negative (–) lead to
terminal B, check that the test bulb does not light up.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
A and check that the test bulb lights up.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Z09972
Author:
Date:
2274
BE–55
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
BE0AL–03
LOCATION
Defogger Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
DEFOG M–Fuse
HTR Fuse
MIR–HTR Fuse
Defogger Relay
Mirror Defogger
Defogger Wire
Z19051
Author:
Date:
2275
BE–56
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
BE0AM–03
INSPECTION
Switch side:
2
1.
INSPECT DEFOGGER SWITCH CONTINUITY
Check that is continuity exists between terminals 2 and 6.
If continuity is not as specified, check the bulb.
1
6 5 4 3
N20315
2.
(a)
5
ON
4
3
N20314
INSPECT DEFOGGER TIMER OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
4 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 3.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
5 through a 3.4–W tester bulb.
(c) Push the defogger switch ON, check that the indicator
light and test bulb light up for 12 to 18 minutes, then the
indicator light and test bulb light goes out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
3.
INSPECT DEFOGGER TIMER CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the switch and inspect the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in the table.
Wire harness side:
1
2
3 4 5 6
S–6–1
Z08467
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
4 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
5 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
5 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
Connect terminals 3 and 5.
Defogger system operation is normal
–
If the circuit is not as specified, replace the switch.
4.
1
2
3
5
1
5
2
3
INSPECT DEFOGGER RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
N14863
Author:
Date:
2276
BE–57
BODY ELECTRICAL
5.
(a)
6
4
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
w/ Heater:
INSPECT MIRROR DEFOGGER
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
4 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 6.
Check that the mirror becomes warm.
(b)
HINT:
It takes short time for the mirror to become warm.
N21371
Tester Probe
Heat Wire
Tin Foil
BE4029
At Center
6.
INSPECT DEFOGGER WIRE
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, use a soft, dry cloth, and
wipe the glass in the direction of the wire. Take care
not to damage the wires.
Do not use detergents or glass cleaners with abrasive
ingredients.
When measuring voltage, wind a piece of tin foil
around the top of the negative probe and press the foil
against the wire with your finger, as shown.
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Turn the defogger switch ON.
(c) Inspect the voltage at the center of each heat wire, as
shown.
Voltage
Criteria
Approx. 5V
Okay (No break in wire)
Approx.10V or 0V
Broken wire
BE0123
Several
0 Volt Volts
Broken
Wire
BE0124
HINT:
If there is approximately 10 V, the wire is broken between the
center of the wire and the positive (+) end. If there is no voltage,
the wire is broken between the center of the wire and ground.
(d) Place the voltmeter positive (+) lead against the defogger
positive (+) terminal.
(e) Place the voltmeter negative (–) lead with the foil strip
against the heat wire at the positive (+) terminal end and
slide it toward the negative (–) terminal end.
(f)
The point where the voltmeter deflects from zero to several V is the place where the heat wire is broken.
HINT:
If the heat wire is not broken, the voltmeter indicates 0 V at the
positive (+) end of the heat wire but gradually increases to about
12 V as the meter probe is moved to the other end.
Author:
Date:
2277
BE–58
BODY ELECTRICAL
7.
(a)
Repair Point
(b)
Broken
Wire
(c)
Masking Tape
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
IF NECESSARY, REPAIR DEFOGGER WIRE
Clean the broken wire tips with grease, wax and silicone
remover.
Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire to be
repaired.
Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No.
4817).
BE0150
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No. 4817
or equivalent).
Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount to the wire.
After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
Do not repair the defogger wire for at least 24 hours.
BE0151
Author:
Date:
2278
BE–59
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AN–03
LOCATION
Ignition Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
POWER M–Fuse
GAUGE Fuse
Power Main Relay
Integration Relay
Door Courtesy Switch
Power Window Switch
Power Window Switch
Power Window Switch
Power Window Master Switch
Power Window Regulator
Assembly
Power Window Motor
Door Courtesy
Switch
Power Window Regulator Assembly
Power Window Motor
Power Window Regulator Assembly
Power Window Motor
Z19052
Author:
Date:
2279
BE–60
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AO–02
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
6 5 4
3 2 1
141312 1110 9 8 7
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH CONTINUITY
Inspect the front driver’s switch.
Window unlock:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
3–8–9
4–5–6
Continuity
OFF
3–4–5
4–5–6
Continuity
DOWN
6–8–9
3–4–5
Continuity
Window lock:
Switch position
Tester connection
UP
3–8–9
4–5–6
Continuity
OFF
3–4–5
4–5–6
Continuity
DOWN
6–8–9
3–4–5
Continuity
N20559
(b)
Specified condition
Inspect the front passenger’s switch.
Window unlock:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
8 – 9 – 11
4 – 5 – 13
Continuity
OFF
4 – 5 – 11
4 – 5 – 13
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 13
4 – 5 – 11
Continuity
Window lock:
(c)
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
8 – 9 – 11
Continuity
OFF
11 – 13
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 13
Continuity
Inspect the rear left switch.
Window unlock:
Switch position
Tester connection
UP
8 – 9 – 10
4 – 5 – 12
Continuity
OFF
4 – 5 – 10
4 – 5 – 12
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 12
4 – 5 – 10
Continuity
Author: MH
Specified condition
Date: 3/7/02
2280
BE–61
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Window lock:
(d)
Switch position
Tester connection
UP
8 – 9 – 10
Continuity
Specified condition
OFF
10 – 12
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 12
Continuity
Inspect the rear right switch.
Window unlock:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
7–8–9
4 – 5 – 14
Continuity
OFF
4–5–7
4 – 5 – 14
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 14
4–5–7
Continuity
Window lock:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
7–8–9
Continuity
OFF
7 – 14
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 14
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the master switch.
2.
Unlock
(a)
(b)
4
8
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH ILLUMINATION
Set the window lock switch to the unlock position.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
8 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 4, and check that
all the illuminations light up.
N02358
(c)
Set the window lock switch to the lock position, check that
all the passenger’s power window switch illuminations go
out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the master switch.
Lock
4
8
N02359
Author:
Date:
2281
BE–62
BODY ELECTRICAL
3
3.
6
(a)
(b)
(c)
Z05738
(d)
3
(e)
6
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Using an ammeter:
INSPECT ONE–TOUCH POWER WINDOW SYSTEM/
CURRENT OF CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the master switch.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 3 on the wire harness side connector and the negative
(–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
6 on the wire harness side connector.
As the window goes down, check that the current flow is
approximately 7 A.
Check that the current increases up to approximately
14.5 A or more when the window stops going down.
HINT:
The circuit breaker opens some 4 – 40 seconds after the window stops going down, so that check must be done before the
circuit breaker operates.
If the operation is as specified, replace the master switch.
Z05739
4.
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
Z05740
8
(d)
(e)
Using an ammeter with a current – measuring probe:
INSPECT ONE–TOUCH POWER WINDOW SYSTEM/
CURRENT OF CIRCUIT
Remove the master switch with connector connected.
Attach a current–measuring probe to terminal 8 of the
wire harness.
Turn the ignition switch ON and set the power window
switch in the down position.
As the window goes down, check that the current flow is
approximately 7 A.
Check that the current increases up to approximately
14.5 A or more when the window stops going down.
HINT:
The circuit breaker opens some 4 – 40 seconds after the window stops going down, so that check must be done before the
circuit breaker operates.
If operation is as specified, replace the master switch.
Z05741
Author: MH
Date: 3/7/02
2282
BE–63
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
5.
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the master switch and inspect
the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in the following page.
Wire harness side:
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
e–14–1–A
Z05742
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
4 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
8 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
*No voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
*Exceptions: During 60 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned ON to OFF (ACC) or until driver or a passenger’s door
is opened after the ignition switch is turned ON to OFF (ACC).
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
6.
5 4321
Front passenger’s door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
1 – 2, 3 – 4
Continuity
OFF
1 – 2, 3 – 5
Continuity
DOWN
1 – 4, 3 – 5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20560
7.
5 432 1
Rear door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
1 – 3, 4 – 5
Continuity
OFF
1 – 2, 4 – 5
Continuity
DOWN
1 – 2, 3 – 5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20561
8.
1
2
3
5
5
1
2
3
INSPECT POWER MAIN RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
N14863
Author:
Date:
2283
BE–64
BODY ELECTRICAL
9.
TMMK made:
(a)
2
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Left side door:
INSPECT MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, and check that
the motor turns clockwise.
1
TMC made:
N20555
(b)
Reverse the polarity, and check that the motor turns counterclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
TMMK made:
2
1
TMC made:
N20556
Author: MH
Date: 3/7/02
2284
BE–65
BODY ELECTRICAL
10.
TMMK made:
(a)
2
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Right side door:
INSPECT MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, and check that
the motor turns clockwise.
1
TMC made:
N20557
(b)
Reverse the polarity, and check that the motor turns counterclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
TMMK made:
2
1
TMC made:
N20558
Author:
Date:
2285
BE–66
BODY ELECTRICAL
11.
1
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
I21314
(d)
(e)
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Driver’s door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the master switch.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 2 on the wire harness side connector and the negative
(–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 on the wire harness side connector, and raise the window to the fully position.
Continue to apply voltage and check that the current
changes to less than 1 A within 4 to 90 seconds.
Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
(f)
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 1, and check that the window begins to
descend.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
2
1
I21315
12.
2
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
I21312
(d)
(e)
Passenger ’s door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the power window switch.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 1 on the wire harness side connector and the negative
(–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 on the wire harness side connector, and raise the window to the fully position.
Continue to apply voltage and check that the current
changes to less than 1 A within 4 to 90 seconds.
Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
Author: MH
Date: 3/7/02
2286
BE–67
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(f)
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 1 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 2, and check that the window begins to
descend.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
2
1
I21313
13.
2
1
I12561
2
1
Rear Door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
(a) Disconnect the connector from the power window switch.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 1 on the wire harness side connector and the negative
(–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 on the wire harness side connector, and raise the window to the fully position.
(d) Continue to apply voltage and check that the current
changes to less than 1 A within 4 to 90 seconds.
(e) Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
(f)
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 1, and check that the window begins to
descend.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
I12560
14.
Type B:
(b) Close
(c) Open
A3
N20564
Key–off power window signal:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE B) OPERATION
HINT:
When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the key–off power
window signal.
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal A3 and the negative (–) lead to body ground.
(b) Close the door with ignition switch turned to LOCK or
ACC, and check that the meter needle indicates battery
positive voltage.
(c) Open the door and check that the meter needle indicates
0 V.
Author:
Date:
2287
BE–68
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the meter
needle indicates battery positive voltage again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Type B:
A3
N20565
Type C:
15.
(b) Close
(c) Open
A12
N20566
Key–off power window signal:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE C) OPERATION
HINT:
When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the key–off power
window signal.
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal A12 and the negative (–) lead to body ground.
(b) Close the door with ignition switch turned to LOCK or
ACC, and check that the meter needle indicates battery
positive voltage.
(c)
Open the door and check that the meter needle indicates
0 V.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the meter
needle indicates battery positive voltage again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
16. INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY CIRCUIT
(See page XX–XXX)
Type C:
A12
N20567
Author: MH
Date: 3/7/02
2288
BE–69
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AP–02
LOCATION
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
POWER M–Fuse
CIG Fuse
DOOR Fuse
Integration Relay
Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
Door Lock Assembly
Door Lock Motor
Door Unlock Detection Switch
Power Window Master Switch
Door Lock Control Switch
Door Lock Assembly
Door Lock Motor
Door Unlock Detection Switch
Door Lock Control Switch
Z19053
Author:
Date:
2289
BE–70
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AQ–02
INSPECTION
1.
N21181
Master switch:
INSPECT DRIVER’S DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
LOCK
2–4
OFF
–
UNLOCK
4–7
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
INSPECT PASSENGER’S DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
LOCK
3–6
OFF
–
UNLOCK
3–5
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20568
3.
OFF
UNLOCK
LOCK
1
2
3
w/ Theft deterrent system:
INSPECT DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
LOCK
2–1
OFF
–
UNLOCK
3–1
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20569
4.
Lock
Unlock
w/o Theft deterrent system:
INSPECT DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
LOCK
2–1
OFF
–
UNLOCK
3–1
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N21580
4
5.
1
Lock
Unlock
INSPECT DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
OFF (Door Lock set to
LOCK)
–
ON (Door Lock set to
UNLOCK)
1–4
Specified condition
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20673
Author:
Date:
2290
BE–71
BODY ELECTRICAL
3
2
3
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
6.
(a)
INSPECT MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, and check that
the door lock link moves to UNLOCK position.
(b) Remove the polarity and check that the door lock link
moves to LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
2
N20570
7.
Front door
Rear door
(a)
(b)
Using an ammeter:
INSPECT PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to battery negative (–) terminal, and check that the current changes from approximately 3.2 A to less than 0.5 A within 20 to 70 seconds.
N20571
Front door
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 3, and check that the door lock moves to
the LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
Rear door
N20572
Front door
8.
Rear door
(a)
(b)
Using an ammeter with a current–measuring probe:
INSPECT PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Attach a current–measuring probe to either the positive
(+) lead or the negative (–) lead, and check that the current changes from approximately 3.2 A to less than 0.5 A
within 20 to 70 seconds.
N20573
Front door
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, reverse the polarity, and
check that the door lock moves to the LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
Rear door
N20572
Author:
Date:
2291
BE–72
BODY ELECTRICAL
Type B:
9.
Lock
A25
A12
N20574
Type B:
Unlock
A25
A12
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Door lock signal:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (Type B) OPERATION
HINT:
When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the door lock signal.
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal A12 and the negative (–) lead to terminal A25.
(b) Set the door lock control switch to UNLOCK and check
that the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage
for approximately 0.2 seconds.
(c) Reverse the polarity of the voltmeter leads.
(d) Set the door lock control switch to LOCK and check that
the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage for
approximately 0.2 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
N20575
Type C:
10.
Lock
A7 A6
N20576
Type C:
Unlock
A7
A6
Door lock signal:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (Type C) OPERATION
HINT:
When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the door lock signal.
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal A6 and the negative (–) lead to terminal A7.
(b) Set the door lock control switch to UNLOCK and check
that the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage
for approximately 0.2 seconds.
(c) Reverse the polarity of the voltmeter leads.
(d) Set the door lock control switch to LOCK and check that
the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage for
approximately 0.2 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
11. INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY CIRCUIT
(See page BE–14)
N20577
Author:
Date:
2292
BE–73
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
BE0AR–02
LOCATION
E/G Room J/B No.2
DOME Fuse
Ignition Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
POWER Fuse
GAUGE Fuse
Power Main Relay
Integration Relay
Sliding Control Relay and Switch
Sliding Roof Motor
Limit Switch
Z19490
Author:
Date:
2293
BE–74
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
BE0AS–02
INSPECTION
Wire harness side:
1.
1 2
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF CONTROL RELAY AND
SWITCH CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the relay and switch and inspect
the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in the table.
3
4 5 6 7 8
s–8–1
N21643
TMMK made:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1–5
Constant
Continuity
2 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
3 – Ground
Limit switch No.1 is OFF (Sliding roof is in a
closed position)
No continuity
3 – Ground
Limit switch No.1 is ON (Sliding roof is in an open
position)
Continuity
7 – Ground
Limit switch No.2 is OFF (Sliding roof is in a tilt
up position)
No continuity
7 – Ground
Limit switch No.2 is ON (Sliding roof is in the
open position)
Continuity
8 – Ground
Limit switch No.3 is OFF (Sliding roof is in a
closed position)
No continuity
8 – Ground
Limit switch No.3 is ON (Sliding roof is in an open
position)
Continuity
4 – Ground
Ignition switch is in a LOCK or ACC position
* No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch is in an ON position
Battery positive voltage
TMC made:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1–5
Constant
Continuity
2 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
3 – Ground
No.1 limit switch OFF (Sliding roof closed)
No continuity
3 – Ground
No.1 limit switch ON (Sliding roof opened)
Continuity
7 – Ground
No.2 limit switch OFF (Sliding roof tilted up open
approx. 200 mm (7.87 in.)
No continuity
7 – Ground
No.2 limit switch ON (Except for conditions
mentioned above)
Continuity
4 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
* No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
*: Exceptions: For 60 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
ON to OFF (ACC) or until driver or passenger door is opened
after the ignition switch is turned ON to OFF (ACC).
If the circuit is not as specified, replace the relay and switch.
Author:
Date:
2294
BE–75
BODY ELECTRICAL
Webasto type:
2
1
2.
(a)
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the
motor turns counterclockwise (moves to the close and up
side).
DENSO type:
1
2
N21182
(b)
Webasto type:
2
1
Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clockwise
(moves to the open and down side).
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
DENSO type:
1
2
N21183
3.
(a)
INSPECT CIRCUIT BREAKER OPERATION
With the sliding roof in the fully opened position, hold the
sliding roof switch in ”OPEN” position and check that is a
circuit breaker operation noise is heard within 10 to 60 seconds.
Within
10 to 60
seconds
N21644
Author:
Date:
2295
BE–76
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
(b)
With the sliding roof in fully opened position, hold the sliding roof switch in ”TILT UP” position and check that the
sliding roof begins to close within 60 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
within 60
seconds
N21645
4.
No.3
Limit Switch
ON
OFF
Switch position
Tester connection
No.1
Limit Switch
No.1 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
3–5
No continuity
No.2
Limit Switch
No.1 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
3–5
Continuity
No.2 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
3–6
No continuity
No.2 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
3–6
Continuity
No.3 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
3–4
No continuity
No.3 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
3–4
Continuity
N21872
5.
ON
OFF
TMMK made:
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF LIMIT SWITCH CIRCUIT
No.1
Limit Switch
No.2
Limit Switch
4 1
5 2
6 3
N21180
Specified condition
TMC made:
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF LIMIT SWITCH CIRCUIT
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
No.1 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
4–5
No continuity
No.1 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
4–5
Continuity
No.2 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
4–6
No continuity
No.2 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
4–6
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
6.
INSPECT KEY–OFF SLIDING ROOF OPERATION
(See integration relay circuit on page BE–14)
Author:
Date:
2296
BE–77
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AT–02
LOCATION
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
CIG Fuse
Lifter Motor
Reclining Motor
Power Seat Switch
Lifter Motor
Sliding Motor
Power Seat Switch
Z19504
Author:
Date:
2297
BE–78
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AU–02
INSPECTION
Lifter Up
1.
(a)
Down
Reclining
Forward
Rear
(b)
Front
Rear
Slide
(c)
5 4
3 21
121110 9 8 7 6
I01932
TMC made:
INSPECT DRIVER’S SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Inspect the slide switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
FRONT
4 – 6, 8 – 11
Continuity
Specified condition
OFF
4 – 6, 6 – 8
Continuity
BACK
6 – 8, 4 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the lifter switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
2 – 11, 3 – 6
Continuity
OFF
3 – 6, 2 – 6
Continuity
DOWN
2 – 6, 3 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the reclining switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FORWARD
1 – 11, 5 – 6
Continuity
OFF
1 – 6, 5 – 6
Continuity
REAR
1 – 6, 5 – 11
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
TMMK made:
INSPECT DRIVER’S SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Inspect the slide switch.
(b)
(c)
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FRONT
2 – 11, 4 – 7
Continuity
OFF
4 – 11, 4 – 7
Continuity
BACK
2 – 7, 4 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the lifter switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
2 – 5, 4 – 8
Continuity
OFF
4 – 5, 4 – 8
Continuity
DOWN
2 – 8, 4 – 5
Continuity
Inspect the reclining switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FORWARD
2 – 12, 4 – 6
Continuity
OFF
4 – 12, 4 – 6
Continuity
REAR
2 – 6, 4 – 12
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Author:
Date:
2298
BE–79
BODY ELECTRICAL
3.
Lifter Up
(a)
Down
Reclining
Forward
Front
Rear
(b)
Rear
Slide
(c)
5 4
3 21
121110 9 8 7 6
I01932
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
TMC made:
INSPECT PASSENGER’S SEAT CONTINUITY
Inspect the slide switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FRONT
4 – 6, 8 – 11
Continuity
OFF
4 – 6, 6 – 8
Continuity
BACK
6 – 8, 4 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the lifter switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
2 – 6, 3 – 11
Continuity
OFF
3 – 6, 2 – 6
Continuity
DOWN
3 – 6, 2 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the reclining switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FORWARD
5 – 6, 1 – 11
Continuity
OFF
1 – 6, 5 – 6
Continuity
REAR
1 – 6, 5 – 11
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
4.
TMMK made:
INSPECT PASSENGER’S SEAT CONTINUITY
(a) Inspect the slide switch.
(b)
(c)
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FRONT
2 – 11, 4 – 7
Continuity
OFF
4 – 11, 4 – 7
Continuity
BACK
2 – 7, 4 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the lifter switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
2 – 8, 4 – 5
Continuity
OFF
4 – 5, 4 – 8
Continuity
DOWN
2 – 5, 4 – 8
Continuity
Inspect the reclining switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FORWARD
2 – 12, 4 – 6
Continuity
OFF
4 – 12, 4 – 6
Continuity
REAR
2 – 6, 4 – 12
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
(a)
5.
(a)
INSPECT SLIDE MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the
motor turns counterclockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
(b)
2
1
2
1
N21865
Author:
Date:
2299
BE–80
BODY ELECTRICAL
2
6.
1
(a)
(b)
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SLIDE MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 2 and
the negative (–) lead to the battery negative (–) terminal,
then move the seat cushion to the front position.
Continue to apply voltage, check that the current changes
to less than 1 ampere within 4 to 90 seconds.
N21866
2
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 1, check that the seat cushion begins to
move backwards.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
1
N21867
(a)
7.
(a)
INSPECT LIFTER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the
motor turns counterclockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
(b)
2
1
1
2
N21865
2
8.
(a)
1
(b)
INSPECT LIFTER PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 2 and
the negative (–) lead to the battery negative (–) terminal,
then move the seat cushion to the highest position.
Continue to apply voltage, check that the current changes
to less than 1 ampere within 4 to 90 seconds.
N21868
2
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 1, check that the seat cushion begins to
fall down.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
1
N21869
Author:
Date:
2300
BE–81
BODY ELECTRICAL
(a)
1
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
9.
(a)
INSPECT RECLINING MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the
motor turns counterclockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
(b)
2
–
1
2
N21865
2
10.
1
(a)
(b)
INSPECT RECLINING MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 1 and
the negative (–) lead to the battery negative (–) terminal,
then recline the seat back to the most forward position.
Continue to apply voltage, check that the current change
to less than 1 ampere within 4 to 90 seconds.
N21870
2
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 1 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 2, check that the seat back starts to fall
backward.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
1
N21871
Author:
Date:
2301
BE–82
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AV–03
LOCATION
Mirror Control Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
CIG Fuse
LH Mirror
Mirror Motor
RH Mirror
Mirror Motor
Z19488
Author:
Date:
2302
BE–83
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AW–03
INSPECTION
R
L
1.
MIRROR
OFF
RIGHT SIDE
LEFT SIDE
UP
LEFT
OFF
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
–
UP
1 – 9, 6 – 10
Continuity
DOWN
1 – 10, 6 – 9
Continuity
LEFT
5 – 9, 6 – 10
Continuity
RIGHT
5 – 10, 6 – 9
Continuity
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
Master switch right side:
INSPECT MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
RIGHT
DOWN
4 3
10 9 8
Master switch left side:
INSPECT MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
2 1
7 6 5
BE2357 h–10–2
Z16591
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
–
UP
6 – 10, 7 – 9
Continuity
DOWN
6 – 9, 7 – 10
Continuity
LEFT
6 – 10, 8 – 9
Continuity
RIGHT
6 – 9, 8 – 10
Continuity
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
3.
(a)
TMMK made
(w/o Heater)
1
(b)
2
TMC made
(w/o Heater)
3
2
TMMK made
(w/ Heater)
3
2
(c)
INSPECT MIRROR MOTOR
TMMK made (w/o Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the mirror
turns to left side.
TMC made (w/o Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the mirror
turns to left side.
TMMK made (w/ Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the mirror
turns to left side.
N21184
Author:
Date:
2303
BE–84
BODY ELECTRICAL
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
Reverse the polarity and check that the mirror turns to
right side.
(e)
TMMK made (w/o Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the
mirror turns upward.
TMC made (w/o Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the
mirror turns upward.
TMMK made (w/ Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the
mirror turns upward.
TMMK made
(w/o Heater)
TMC made
(w/o Heater)
–
TMMK made
(w/ Heater)
N21185
TMMK made
(w/o Heater)
(f)
(g)
TMC made
(w/o Heater)
TMMK made
(w/ Heater)
N21186
Author:
Date:
2304
BE–85
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
(h)
TMMK made
(w/o Heater)
TMC made
(w/o Heater)
Reverse the polarity, check that the mirror turns downward.
If operation is not as specified, replace the mirror assembly.
TMMK made
(w/ Heater)
N21187
Author:
Date:
2305
BE–86
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE0AX–03
DESCRIPTION
1.
RADIO WAVE BAND
The radio wave bands used in radio broadcasting are as follows:
30 kHz
Frequency
Designation
3 MHz
300 kHz
LF
Modulation method
300 MHz
VHF
HF
MF
AM
Radio wave
30 MHz
FM
Amplitude modulation
Frequency modulation
LF: Low frequency MF: Medium Frequency HF: High Frequency VHF: Very High Frequency
2.
SERVICE AREA
There are great differences in the size of the service area for AM
and FM monaural. Sometimes FM stereo broadcasts cannot be
received even through AM comes in very clearly.
Not only does FM stereo have the smallest service area, but it
also picks up static and other types of interference (”noise”)
easily.
FM (Stereo)
FM (Monaural)
AM
BE2818
3.
RECEPTION PROBLEMS
Besides the problem of static, there are also the problems
called ”fading”, ”multipath” and ”fade out”. These problems are
caused not by electrical noise but by the nature of the radio
waves themselves.
Fading
Ionosphere
Fading
Besides electrical interference, AM broadcasts are
also susceptible to other types of interference, especially at night. This is because AM radio waves
bounce off the ionosphere at night. These radio
waves then interfere with the signals from the same
transmitter that reach the vehicle’s antenna directly.
This type of interference is called ”fading”.
BE2819
Author:
Date:
2306
BE–87
BODY ELECTRICAL
Multipath
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Multipath
One type of interference caused by bouncing of radio waves off obstructions is called ”multipath”. Multipath occurs when a signal from the broadcast
transmitter antenna bounces off buildings and
mountains and interferes with the signal that is received directly.
Fade Out
Because FM radio waves are of higher frequencies
than AM radio waves, they bounce off buildings,
mountains, and other obstructions. For this reason,
FM signals often seem to gradually disappear or
fade away as the vehicle goes behind a building or
other obstructions. This is called ”fade out”.
BE2820
Fade Out
BE2821
4.
NOISE PROBLEMS
(a) Questionnaire for noise:
It is very important for noise troubleshooting to have good understanding of the claims from the customers, so that make the
best use of following quenstionnaire and diagnose the problem
accurately.
AM
FM
Noise occurs at a specific place.
Strong possibility of foreign noise.
Noise occurs when listening to
faint broadcasting.
There is a case that the same program is broadcasted
from each local station and that may be the case you are
listening to different station if the program is the same.
Noise occurs only at night.
Strong possibility of the beat from a distant broadcasting.
Noise occurs while driving and
at a specific place.
Strong possibility of multipath noise and fading noise
caused by the changes of FM waves.
HINT:
In the case that the noise occurrence condition does not meet
any of the above quenstionnaire, check based on the ”Trouble
Phenomenon”.
Refer to previous page for multipath and fading.
Author:
Date:
2307
BE–88
BODY ELECTRICAL
Noise
Glass Printed Antenna
Noise
Matlers that require attention when checking:
Noise coming into the radio usually has no harm for
practical use as the noise protection is taken and it
is hardly thinkable for an extremely loud noise to
come in. When extremely loud noise comes into the
radio, check if the grounding is normal where the
antenna is installed.
Check if all the regular noise prevention parts are
properly installed and if there is any installation of
non–authorized parts and non–authorized wiring.
If you leave the radio out of tune (not tuning), it is
easy to diagnose the phenomenon as noise occurs
frequently.
(c)
Antenna and noise:
Electronic signal received by the antenna will reach to the
radio transmitting through the core wire of the coaxial
cable. Any noise wave other than radio wave is mixed into
this core wire, that naturally causes noise in the radio and
poor sound quality. In order to prevent these noises from
mixing into the radio, the core wire inside the coaxial cable
is covered with a mesh wire called shield wire. This shield
wire shelters the noise and transmits it to the ground, thus
preventing noise from mixing in. If this shield wire has
grounding failure, that causes noise.
(d)
Choke coil and noise:
The choke coil is connected in the rear window defogger
circuit. This is conneted so to prevent noise from mixing
into the radio by making the noise current included in the
power source of the rear window defogger flow to the
ground.
Signal
Radio
Noise
N21545
to Radio
Battery
Choke Coil
AUDIO SYSTEM
(b)
Noise
Noise
–
Noise
N21546
Author:
Date:
2308
BE–89
BODY ELECTRICAL
Plug (Main)
Antenna
Terminal
(Main)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Plug (Sub)
Antenna
Terminal
(Sub)
I00399
5.
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Glass printed antenna:
GROUNDING FOR THE ANTENNA CORD AND CHOKE
COIL
HINT:
During troubleshooting, in case that the antenna code continuity check, grounding check and grounding check of the choke
coil are needed, please check refering to the following illustration.
Terminal connection
Normal condition
(1) ↔ (2)
Continuity
(3) ↔ (4)
Continuity
Ground point:
Antenna Cord
Center Brace
Pillar (RH)
Choke Coil
N21548 I00402
I00403
Pillar (LH)
I00407
Author:
Date:
2309
BE–90
BODY ELECTRICAL
6.
Antenna
Terminal
Plug
(1)
(2)
I00400
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Fixed mast antenna:
GROUNDING FOR THE ANTENNA CORD AND CHOKE
COIL
HINT:
During troubleshooting, in case that the antenna code continuity check, grounding check and grounding check of the choke
coil are needed, please check refering to the following illustrations.
Terminal connection
Normal condition
(1) ↔ (2)
Continuity
Ground point:
Antenna Cord
Center Brace
Luggage Room (RH side)
Noise Filter
I00427 I00428
I00429
Pillar (LH)
I00408
Author:
Date:
2310
BE–91
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE0AY–05
TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTICE:
When replacing the internal mechanism (computer part) of the audio system, be careful that no part
of your body or clothing comes in contact with the terminals of the leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
HINT:
This inspection procedure is a simple troubleshooting which should be carried out on the vehicle during system operation and was prepared on the assumption of system component troubles (except for the wires and
connectors, etc.).
Always inspect the trouble taking the following items into consideration.
Open or short circuit of the wire harness
Connector or terminal connection fault
Problem
Radio
Tape Player
CD Player
Noise
No.
Radio not operating when power switch turned ’ON’.
1
Display indicates when power switch turned ’ON’, but no sound (including ’noise’)
is produced.
2
Noise present, but AM – FM not operating.
3
Any speaker does not work.
4
Either AM or FM does not work, reception poor (volume faint), Fewer station presets.
5
Poor reception.
6
Sound quality poor.
7
Preset memory disappears.
8
Cassette tape cannot be inserted.
9
Cassette tape is inserted, but no power.
10
Power coming in, but tape player not operating.
11
Either speaker does not work.
12
Sound quality poor. (volume faint)
13
Tape jammed, malfunction with tape speed or auto–reverse.
14
Cassette tape will not be ejected.
15
CD cannot be inserted.
16
CD inserted, but no power.
17
Power coming in, but CD player not operating.
18
Sound jumps.
19
Sound quality poor (Volume faint).
20
Either speaker does not work.
21
CD will not be ejected.
22
Noise occurs.
23
Noise produced by vibration or shock while driving.
24
Noise produced when engine starts.
25
The term ”AM” includes LW, MW and SW, and the term ”FM” includes UKW.
Author:
Date:
2311
BE–92
BODY ELECTRICAL
1
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
RADIO NOT OPERATING WHEN POWER SWITCH TURNED ’ON’
Radio–CD Plater Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Plater Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does tape or CD player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
NG
Replace fuse.
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
OK
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Is ACC applied to radio?
Yes
NG
Replace fuse.
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
OK
No
Is +B applied to radio?
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio is OK?
+B wire harness faulty.
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
Author:
Date:
2312
BE–93
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Does tape or CD player operate normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
No
NG
Replace fuse.
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
OK
Is ACC applied to power amplifier?
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier or wire harness faulty.
Yes
No
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier or wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
I03349
Author:
Date:
2313
BE–94
BODY ELECTRICAL
2
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
DISPLAY INDICATES WHEN POWER SWITCH TURNED
’ON’, BUT NO SOUND (INCLUDING ’NOISE’) IS PRODUCED
Radio
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does tape or CD player operate normally?
Yes
Radio faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC applied to radio?
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to radio?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio faulty.
I03350
Author:
Date:
2314
BE–95
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does tape player operate normally?
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC applied to power amplifier.
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier.
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
No
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Speaker faulty.
No
No
Hiss noise from speaker?
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty. Recheck system after repair.
V08239
Author:
Date:
2315
BE–96
BODY ELECTRICAL
3
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
NOISE PRESENT, BUT AM–FM NOT OPERATING
Yes
Does tape player operate normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Yes
Separate amplifier?
No
Hiss noise from speaker?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
No
Radio assembly faulty.
4
Radio
ANY SPEAKER DOSE NOT WORK
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does tape or CD player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is hiss noise produced by non–functioning speaker?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does tape player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is hiss noise produced by non–functioning speaker?
Yes
Radio assembly
Recheck system after repair.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
No
Yes
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Speaker faulty.
No
Power amplifier faulty. Recheck system after repair.
I03351
Author:
Date:
2316
BE–97
BODY ELECTRICAL
5
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
EITHER AM OR FM DOES NOT WORK, RECEPTION
POOR (VOLUME FAINT), FEWER STATION PRESETS
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Problem with radio wave signals or location?
Yes
Poor signals, poor location.
No
Are both AM or FM defective?
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Is power for the antenna being output from the radio assembly?
No
Yes
Go to No.15
Does tape player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Problem with radio wave signals or location?
Yes
Poor signals, poor location.
No
Are both AM and FM defective?
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Is power for the antenna being output from the radio assembly?
No
Yes
Go to No.15
Does tape player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Hiss noise from speaker?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty. Recheck system after repair.
V08242
I03352
Author:
Date:
2317
BE–98
BODY ELECTRICAL
6
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
POOR RECEPTION
Is the condition bad in comparison with other vehicle?
Yes
An electric wave environment.
No
Yes
Is there any additional installation parts? (Sun shade film,
telephone antenna etc.).
Does the condition get better if removing them?
Yes
No
No
Check if there is any scratch and breaking in a
wire on the glass antenna and the defogger pattern.
(See page BE–115)
Influence of additional installation parts.
Yes
Repair
No
Is the contact of the plug jack of the radio OK?
No
Check for contact.
Yes
No
Does the condition get better by using the outer
antenna? (Such as pillar antenna)
Check the radio.
Yes
No
Is the contact of the antenna terminal on the glass
surface and the defogger terminal?
Measure for contact.
Yes
No
Is the continuity of the antenna cord OK?
Exchange the antenna cord.
Yes
NG
Check the grounding of the antenna, antenna cord,
choke coil and noise filter.
Grounding failure.
OK
Yes
Does the condition get better by exchanging the choke
coil?
Exchange the choke coil.
No
Yes
Does the condition get better by exchanging the
antenna cord?
Exchange the antenna cord.
No
Exchange the glass.
I01472
Author:
Date:
2318
BE–99
BODY ELECTRICAL
7
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
SOUND QUALITY POOR
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
No
Is sound quality always bad?
Yes
Is sound quality bad in
certain area only.
Poor signals,
poor location.
No
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Does tape player operate normally?
Radio assembly
faulty.
No
No
Installed properly.
Is speaker properly installed?
Yes
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power amplifier)
Radio–Tape CD Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Is sound quality always bad?
No
Yes
Is sound quality bad only in
certain areas?
Poor signals, poor
location.
No
Yes
Does tape player operate normally?
Yes
No
Radio assembly or power
amplifier faulty.
Does tape player operate normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installe properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly or power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
I03353
Author:
Date:
2319
BE–100
BODY ELECTRICAL
8
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
PRESET MEMORY DISAPPEARS
Radio
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Can cassette tape be inserted in tape player?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Replace fuse.
NG
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Can cassette tape be inserted in tape player?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly?
NG
Power amplifier faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
I03354
Author:
Date:
2320
BE–101
BODY ELECTRICAL
9
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CASSETTE TAPE CANNOT BE INSERTED
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Is there a foreign object inside tape player?
Yes
Remove foreign object.
No
Does auto search button of radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Is there a foreign object inside tape player?
Yes
Remove foreign object.
No
Yes
Does auto search button radio operate normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
NG
Power amplifier faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
V08246
Author:
Date:
2321
BE–102
BODY ELECTRICAL
10
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CASSETTE TAPE IS INSERTED, BUT NO POWER
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normal?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC applied to power amplifier?
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
V08247
Author:
Date:
2322
BE–103
BODY ELECTRICAL
11
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
POWER COMING IN, BUT TAPE PLAYER NOT OPERATING
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Functions OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Function OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Hissing sound from speaker?
Yes
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
V08248
Author:
Date:
2323
BE–104
BODY ELECTRICAL
12
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
EITHER SPEAKER DOES NOT WORK
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is hiss noise produces by non–functioning speaker.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is hiss noise produced by non–functioning speaker.
Yes
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly or power amplifier faulty.
V08249
Author:
Date:
2324
BE–105
BODY ELECTRICAL
13
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
SOUND QUALITY POOR (VOLUME FAINT)
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Functions OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Yes
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Head dirty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Functions OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Yes
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Head dirty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty or power amplifier faulty.
V08250
Author:
Date:
2325
BE–106
BODY ELECTRICAL
14
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
TAPE JAMMED, MALFUNCTION WITH TAPE SPEED OR AUTO–REVERSE
Function OK if different tape (less than 120 mints.) inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Yes
Is there a foreign object inside tape player?
Remove foreign object.
No
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Yes
Head dirty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
15
Tape Player
CASSETTE TAPE WILL NOT BE EJECTED
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
No
Does tape player operate normally?
Cassette tape jammed.
Yes
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
NG
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does tape player operate normally?
No
Cassette tape jammed.
Yes
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
V08251
Author:
Date:
2326
BE–107
BODY ELECTRICAL
16
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CD CANNOT BE INSERTED
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Is CD already inserted?
Eject CD.
No
Yes
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
No
Is +B applied to CD player?
Radio assembly
faulty.
Yes
NG
Check that GND wire harness side
to CD player is OK?
No
OK
CD player faulty.
NG
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
OK
No
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
NG
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
17
CD Player
CD INSERTED, BUT NO POWER
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Is ACC applied to CD player?
No
Radio assembly
faulty.
Yes
No
Check that RAD No.1 and No.2 fuse is OK?
CD player faulty.
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC and +B, +B2 applied to power amplifier?
No
ACC and +B, +B2 wire harness faulty.
I03355
Yes
Is ACC and +B, +B2 applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
I03355
Author:
Date:
2327
BE–108
BODY ELECTRICAL
18
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
POWER COMING IN, BUT CD PLAYER NOT OPERATING
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
No
Is CD inserted with correct side up?
Insert correctly.
Yes
Yes
Function OK if different CD inserted?
CD faulty.
No
Yes
Does radio operate normally?
Is temperature inside cabin hot?
Protective circuit in
operation.
No
No
Has sudden temperature change
occurred inside cabin?
Yes
Yes
Formation of condensation
due to temp. changes.
No
CD player faulty.
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Hissing sound from speaker?
Yes
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
I03356
Author:
Date:
2328
BE–109
BODY ELECTRICAL
19
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
SOUND JUMPS
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Does sound jump only during strong vibration?
Jumping caused by vibration.
No
Is CD player properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
Functions OK if different CD inserted?
Yes
CD faulty.
No
Has sudden temperature change occurred inside cabin?
Yes
No
Formation of condensation due to
temp. changes.
CD player faulty.
20
CD Player
SOUND QUALITY POOR (VOLUME FAINT)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Functions OK if different CD inserted?
CD faulty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
CD player faulty.
No
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly or CD player or Power amplifier faulty.
I03357
Author:
Date:
2329
BE–110
BODY ELECTRICAL
21
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
EITHER SPEAKER DOES NOT WORK
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Does radio operate normally?
CD player.
No
Yes
Is hiss noise produced by non–functioning speaker?
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
No
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK.
Speaker faulty.
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
22
CD Player
CD WILL NOT BE EJECTED
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Is auto search button of radio
operating normally?
Yes
Is +B applied to CD player?
No
Radio assembly
faulty.
Yes
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
CD player faulty.
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B and +B2 applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is +B and +B2 applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
I03358
Author:
Date:
2330
BE–111
BODY ELECTRICAL
23
Noise
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
NOISE OCCURS
No
Does the noise occur only in the radio?
It occurs in the cassette CD. (Go to step 13 or 20)
Yes
Yes
Does the noise occur in a particular place?
An electric environment.
No
Yes
Is there any additional installation part around the glass
printed antenna? (Sunshade film, telephone antenna, etc.)
Does the noise stop by removing it?
Yes
No
No
Influence of the film of the noise radiation of
additional installation part.
Does the noise occur even pulling out the antenna cord
from the radio?
Yes
Check the radio.
No
Yes
Does the noise occur even pulling out the antenna
terminal on the glass surface?
Mixing into the antenna cable.
No
Yes
Is there any adhesive stuck on the bases of the
antenna terminal, defogger terminal and bus bar?
Failure of glass installation. Must plane the butyl rubber.
No
Yes
Does the noise occur even pulling out the defogger
terminal?
Interfering noise from the defogger line and choke
coil. Does the condition get better by exchanging the
choke coil?
No
Exchange the choke coil.
Check the grounding of the antenna, antenna cord,
choke coil and noise filter.
NG
OK
Grounding failure.
Yes
Does the condition get better by exchanging the antenna
cord?
Exchange the antenna cord.
No
Radiates directly to the antenna from the generation
source.
I01473
Author:
Date:
2331
BE–112
BODY ELECTRICAL
24
Noise
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
NOISE PRODUCED BY VIBRATION OR SHOCK WHILE DRIVING
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
No
Is speaker properly installed?
Yes
With vehicle stationary lightly tap each system.
Is noise produced?
Yes
Each system faulty.
No
Noise produced by static electricity accumulated in the vehicle body.
I01474
Author:
Date:
2332
BE–113
BODY ELECTRICAL
25
Noise
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
NOISE PRODUCED WHEN ENGINE STARTS
Whistling noise which becomes high–pitched when
accelerator strongly depressed, disappears shortly
after engine stops.
Yes
Generator noise.
No
Whining noise occurs when A/C is operating.
Yes
A/C noise.
No
Scratching noise occurs during sudden acceleration,
driving on rough roads or when ignition switch is turned
on.
Yes
Fuel gauge noise.
No
Clicking sound heard when horn button is pressed,
then released. Whirring/ grating sound when pressed
continuously.
Yes
Horn noise.
No
Murmuring sound stops when engine stops.
Yes
Ignition noise.
No
Tick–tock noise occurs in co–ordination with
blinking of flasher.
Yes
Turn signal noise.
No
Noise occurs during window washer operation.
Yes
Washer noise.
No
Yes
Scratching noise occurs while engine is running
and continues for a while even after engine stops.
Engine coolant temp. gauge noise.
No
Scraping noise in time with wiper beat.
Yes
Wiper noise.
No
Other type of noise.
I01475
Author:
Date:
2333
BE–114
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE0AZ–05
LOCATION
Tweeter Speaker
Tweeter Speaker
AMP
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
RADIO Fuse
DOME Fuse
Glass Printed
Antenna (MAIN)
Front Speaker
Diversity Only
(SUB)
Rear Speaker
Z19489
Author:
Date:
2334
BE–115
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE0B0–06
INSPECTION
1.
GLASS PRINTED ANTENNA INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, use soft dry cloth, and wipe
the glass in the direction of the wire.
Take care not to damage the wires.
Do not use detergents or glass cleaners with abrasive
ingredients.
NOTICE:
In order not to damage the glass printed antenna, wrap up
the tip of the tester stick with aluminum foil as shown in the
illustration and check by holding the aluminum foil with a
finger.
Tester Probe
Aluminum Foil
BE4029
By placing and moving the tester stick along the glass printed
antenna, check if continuity exists.
I00430
HINT:
Matching module is built in the bus bar of the glass printed antenna (main terminal side) of CAMRY and no continuity exists
between the terminal and the antenna. Therefore, for the continuity checking of the glass printed antenna on the main antenna side of CAMRY, place one probe of the tester on the position
beside the bus bar (position shown in the illustration) and check
by making the other probe of the tester move along.
Matching
module
I00459
2.
(a)
Repair Point
(b)
Broken
Wire
(c)
GLASS PRINTED ANTENNA REPAIR PROCEDURE
Clean the broken wire tips with grease, wax and silicone
remover.
Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire for
repair.
Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No.
4817).
Masking Tape
BE0150
Author:
Date:
2335
BE–116
BODY ELECTRICAL
(d)
(e)
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount of the agent
to the wire.
After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
BE0151
Author:
Date:
2336
BE–117
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
CLOCK
CLOCK
BE0B1–02
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot the clock according to the table below.
Clock will not operate
1
Clock loses or gains time
2
± 1.5 seconds / day
Ground
E
Connector
(Clock Side)
Power Source
(Illumination)
ILL
B
Power Source
(System Operation)
ACC
Power Source
(Display Operation)
4 3 2 1
(Wire Harness Side)
1 2 3 4
Z04388
BE1847 e–4–2–D e–4–1–D
1
CLOCK WILL NOT OPERATE
(a) Check that the battery positive voltage is 10 – 16 V.
(Wire Harness Side)
(Clock Side)
If voltage is not as specified, replace the battery.
(b) Check that the DOME fuse is not blown.
If the fuse is blown, replace the fuse and check for short circuit.
(c) Troubleshoot the clock as follows.
HINT: Inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
B+
GND
e–4–2–D e–4–1–D
Is there battery positive voltage between terminal
B+ and body ground?
No
Open or short circuit in wire harness between
terminal GND and body ground.
No
Open circuit in wire harness between terminal
GND and body ground.
Yes
Does continuity exist between terminal GND
and body ground.
Yes
Replace clock.
V04421
Author:
Date:
2337
BE–118
BODY ELECTRICAL
2
–
CLOCK
CLOCK LOSES OR GAINS TIME
(Clock Side)
(a) Check that the battery positive voltage is 10 – 16 V.
If voltage is not as specified, replace the battery.
(b) Inspect the error of the clock.
Allowable error (per day): ± 1.5 seconds
(Wire Harness Side)
If the error exceeds the allowable error, replace the clock.
(c) Check that the clock adjusting button is caught in position,
and does not return.
If the button is not returned, repair or replace the clock.
(d) Troubleshoot the clock as follows.
HINT: Inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
e–4–2–D
e–4–1–D
B+
GND
Is there 10 – 16 V between terminal B+ and
body ground?
Below 10 V
Locate cause and repair, or recharge battery.
Yes
Adjust or replace clock.
V04422
Author:
Date:
2338
BE–119
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
BE0B2–06
REGISTRATION PROCEDURE
1.
KEY REGISTRATION IN AUTOMATIC REGISTRATION MODE
(a) Registration of a new transponder key.
HINT:
This must be done when you have installed a new ECM.
The new ECM is in the automatic key code registration mode. The already fixed number of key codes
for this ECM can be registered.
On this type of vehicle, up to 4 key codes can be registered.
In the automatic registration mode, the last key registered becomes sub–key.
START
Security indicator blinks until the first
key is inserted. The indicator lights up
after the key registration.
Insert the key in the key cylinder.
Security Indicator ON
Under registration
Security
OFF
Indicator
Registration completion
Remove the key.
Yes
Security Indicator ON
(After the last key (sub–key)
has been registered, the indicator goes off.)
Will you register the
next key?
No
END
Author:
Date:
2339
BE–120
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
HINT:
When a key is not inserted in the key cylinder in the automatic registration mode, the security indicator
always lights on.
When the immobiliser system operations normally and the key is pull out, the security indicator blinks.
When key code registration could not be performed in the automatic registration mode, code 2–1 is
output from the security indicator and when inserting the already registered key, code 2–2 is output.
Blinks
1.2 Sec.
0.8 Sec.
(b)
Code 2–1
0.25 Sec.
1 Sec.
0.25 Sec. 0.5 Sec.
Code2–2
0.25 Sec.
1 Sec.
0.25 Sec.0.5 Sec.
Automatic registration mode completion
If completing the mode forcibly when more than 1 key code have been registered in the automatic registration mode, perform the following procedures.
After 1 more key code have been registered with master key, perform step (1) or (2) without pulling
the key out or inserting the already registered key.
(1) Depress and release brake pedal 5 times or more within 15sec.
(2) With the TOYOTA hand–held tester, require automatic registration mode completion.
Author:
Date:
2340
BE–121
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
2.
REGISTRATION OF ADDITIONAL MASTER KEY
There are 2 ways for registration of additional master key, one is depressing brake pedal and acceleration
pedal and the other is using TOYOTA hand–held tester.
HINT:
It is possible to register up to 7 master key codes including the already registered key code.
When any operation time described below is over, registration mode completes.
When the next procedure is performed while the timer is working, the timer completes counting time,
then next timer starts.
(1) Depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal:
Insert already registered master key in the key
cylinder
Depress and release the acceleration pedal 5
times.
Depress and release the brake pedal 6 times,
and remove the master key.
Within 15 sec.
Within 20 sec.
Within 10 sec.
Insert key to be registered in key cylinder.
Depress and release the acceleration pedal 1
time. (Security indicator blinks)
Within 10 sec.
Within 10 sec.
After 60 sec. additional master key is registered.
(Security indicator is OFF)
Yes
Will you register the
next key?
No
The registration mode completes when pulling
out the key within 10sec. and the brake pedal is
depressed or after indicator is off 10 sec. pass.
Author:
Date:
2341
BE–122
BODY ELECTRICAL
(2)
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
Insert already registered master key in the key cylinder.
Within 120 sec.
Listing TOYOTA hand–held tester select master key registration.
Within 20 sec.
Remove the master key.
Within 10 sec.
Insert key to be registered in key cylinder.
(Security indicator blinks)
Within
10 sec.
Within 10 sec.
After 60 sec., additional master key is registered.
(Security indicator OFF)
Yes
Will you register the
next key?
No
The registration mode completes when pulling out the key
within 10sec. and the brake pedal is depressed or after indicator is off 10 sec. pass.
Author:
Date:
2342
BE–123
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
3.
REGISTRATION ADDITIONAL OF SUB–KEY
There are 2 ways for registration of additional sub–key, one is depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal and the other is using TOYOTA hand–held tester.
HINT:
It is possible top register up to 3 sub–key codes including the already registered key code.
When any operation time described below is over, registration mode completes.
When the next procedure is performed while the timer is working, the timer completes counting time,
then next timer starts.
(1) Depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal:
Insert already registered master key in the key
cylinder
Depress and release the acceleration pedal 4
times.
Depress and release the brake pedal 5 times,
and remove the master key.
Within 15 sec.
Within 20 sec.
Within 10 sec.
Insert key to be registered in key cylinder.
Within 10 sec.
Depress and release the acceleration pedal 1
time. (Security indicator blinks)
Within 10 sec.
After 60 sec. additional sub–key is registered.
(Security indicator is OFF)
Yes
Will you register the
next key?
No
The registration mode completes when pulling
out the key within 10sec. and the brake pedal is
depressed or after indicator is off 10 sec. pass.
Author:
Date:
2343
BE–124
BODY ELECTRICAL
(2)
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
Insert already registered master key in the key cylinder.
Within 120 sec.
Listing TOYOTA hand–held tester select sub–key registration.
Within 20 sec.
Remove the master key.
Within 10 sec.
Insert key to be registered in key cylinder.
(Security indicator blinks)
Within
10 sec.
Within 10 sec.
After 60 sec., additional master key is registered.
(Security indicator OFF)
Yes
Will you register the
next key?
No
The registration mode completes when pulling out the key
within 10sec. and the brake pedal is depressed or after indicator is off 10 sec. pass.
Author:
Date:
2344
BE–125
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
4.
ERASURE OF TRANSPONDER KEY CODE
There are 2 ways for erasure of transponder key code, one is depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal
and the other is using TOYOTA hand–held tester.
NOTICE:
All other master and sub–key codes are deleted leaving the master key code to use the operation.
When using the key which was used before deleting, it is necessary to register the code again.
HINT:
When any operation time described below is over, registration mode completes.
When the next procedure is performed while the timer is working, the timer completes counting time,
then next timer starts.
(1) Depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal:
1. Insert master key in the key cylinder.
Within 15 sec.
2. Depress and release the acceleration pedal 6 times.
Within 20 sec.
3. Depress and release the brake pedal 7 times.
(Security indicator blinks)
Within 10 sec.
4. Remove the master key.
(Security indicator blinks)
END
(Key code erasured)
HINT:
When the key cannot be pulled out in the step 4, key code deletion is canceled.
(Security indicator is OFF)
Author:
Date:
2345
BE–126
BODY ELECTRICAL
(2)
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1. Insert master key in the key cylinder.
Within 120 sec.
2. Require key code deletion from hand–held tester.
(Security indicator blinks)
Within 10 sec.
3. Remove the master key.
END
(Key code erasured)
HINT:
When the key cannot be pulled out in the step 3, key code deletion is canceled.
(Security indicator is OFF)
Author:
Date:
2346
BE–127
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
BE0B3–06
LOCATION
Engine Room J/B No.2
EFI Fuse
Transponder Key Amplifier
Transponder Key Coil
ECM
Instrument Panel J/B
IGN Fuse
I02682
Author:
Date:
2347
BE–128
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
BE0B4–05
INSPECTION
INSPECTION TRANSPONDER KEY COIL CONTINUITY
Check that continuity exists between terminal 1 and 2.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the coil.
I03099
Author:
Date:
2348
BE–1
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
BE16T–01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
COMBINATION METER
METER, GAUGES AND ILLUMINATION:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Tachometer, Fuel Gauge and Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
do not operate.
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–4
–
Fuel Gauge does not operate or abnormal operation.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Fuel Receiver Gauge
Fuel Temperature Sensor (For Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Temperature Sensor (For Fuel Tank)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (For Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (For Fuel Pipe)
ECM
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
BE–5
SF–36
SF–40
SF–42
SF–45
–
BE–4
–
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge does not operate or abnormal
operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
Engine Coolant Temperature Receiver Gauge
Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Gauge
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
BE–5
BE–5
BE–4
–
All illumination lights do not light up.
1. TAIL Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Light Control Rheostat
3. Wire Harness
Only one illumination light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
BE–54*
–
–
–
COMBINATION METER
WARNING LIGHTS:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Warning lights do not light up. (Except Discharge, Open Door and
SRS)
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–4
–
Low Oil Pressure warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–5
BE–4
–
Fuel Level warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Bulb
Fuel Temperature Sensor (For Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Temperature Sensor (For Fuel Tank)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (For Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (For Fuel Pipe)
ECM
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
SF–36
SF–40
SF–42
SF–45
–
BE–4
–
*: See Pub. No. RM654U
Author:
Date:
533
BE–2
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
COMBINATION METER
BE0AI–04
LOCATION
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
E/G Room J/B No.2
ECU–B Fuse
DOME Fuse
Washer Fluid Level
Warning Switch
Combination Meter
Bulb Check Relay
ECM
ABS ECU
Light Control Rheostat
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
GAUGE Fuse
TAIL Fuse
IGN Fuse
Integration Relay
I08447
Author:
Date:
534
BE–3
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
Door Courtesy Switch
PKB Switch
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Light Failure Sensor
Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Engine Coolant Temperature
Sender Gauge
Park/Neutral Position Switch
I08448
Author:
Date:
535
BE–4
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
BE0AJ–04
CIRCUIT
Connector ”A”
1 2 3 4 5 6
Connector ”B”
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
J–13–1–A
C7
E
T
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 1213
J–16–1
B3
C5
A2
A1
C8
F
Connector ”C”
Connector ”C”
Connector ”B”
J–13–1
Connector ”A”
B15
C6
S
B14
ODOMETER
Fuel Level Warning
Seat Belt Warning
ABS Warning
Low Oil Pressure Warning
Cruise Control Indicator
Malfunction Indicator
O/D OFF Indicator
Light Failure Warning
Brake Warning
SLIP Indicator
TRAC Indicator
Washer Level Warning
Discharge Warning
A13
B2
C1
B1
C9
A6
A11
A7
A10
A8
A9
Bulb Check
Relay
Right Turn Indicator
Left Turn Indicator
Security Indicator
L
2
D
N
R
P
Illumination
C13
B8
B11
B12
Hi–Beam Indicator
Open Door Warning
SRS Warning
B6
A4
C4
B5
C10
C2
A12
A3
B7
C3
A5
C11
B4
No.
A
B16
B
C12
B9
B10
B13
C
F : Fuel Gauge
E : Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Gauge
T : Tachometer
S : Speedometer
N20107 N20108
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Wire Harness Side
Engine coolant temperature sender gauge
Ground
Light failure sensor
Integration relay
Traction ECU
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
O/D OFF switch (A/T)
IGN fuse
Turn signal switch
ST relay
ECM
Generator
Oil pressure switch
ECM
Parking brake switch and brake fluid level warning switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Door courtesy switch
DOME fuse
ECU–B fuse
Airbag sensor assembly
ECM
No.1 Vehicle speed sensor
Ground
Turn signal switch
ECM
Traction ECU
ABS ECU
Ground
No.1 Vehicle speed sensor
GAUGE fuse
Igniter
Security ECU
Cruise control ECU
Washer fluid level warning switch
Light control rheostat
TAIL fuse
Z18937
BE–5
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
BE16U–01
INSPECTION
Ignition
Switch
Fuel
Gauge
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the receiver gauge
needle indicates EMPTY.
(c)
Connect terminals 2 on the wire harness side connector
through a 3.4–W test bulb.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the bulb lights up
and the receiver gauge needle moves towards the full
side.
ECM
Battery
I12031
Fuel Gauge
(d)
Ignition
Switch Wire Harness Side
Battery
I12029
HINT:
Because of the silicon oil in the gauge, it will take a short time
for needle to stabilize.
If operation is not as specified, inspect the receiver gauge resistance.
2.
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
A
B
C
N20212
Ignition
Switch
Wire Harness Side
Battery
I12030
Resistance (Ω)
A–B
Approx. 270.1
A–C
Approx. 141.3
B–C
Approx. 128.8
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver
gauge.
3.
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
(See page SF–36)
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Warning Light
Tester connection
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Connect terminals 8 on the wire harness side connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the warning light
lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or inspect wire
harness.
5.
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(See page SF–40)
BE–6
BODY ELECTRICAL
6.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
(a)
(b)
Ignition
Switch
Sender
Gauge
Battery
–
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the receiver
gauge needle indicates COOL.
N20215
(c)
Ground terminal on the wire harness side connector
through a 3.4–W test bulb.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON, and check that the bulb lights
up and the receiver gauge needle moves to the hot side.
If operation is as specified, replace the sender gauge.
Then, recheck the system.
If operation is not as specified, measure the receiver gauge resistance.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
Ignition
Switch
Battery
Test Bulb
(3.4 W)
Wire Harness Side
Z15788
7.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
C
B
A
N20216
Tester connection
Resistance (Ω) *
A–B
Approx. 175.7
A–C
Approx. 54.0
B–C
Approx. 229.7
*: This circuit includes the diode.
HINT:
Connect the test leads so that the current from the ohmmeter
can flow according to the above order.
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver
gauge.
BE–7
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
8.
35.63 ±
0.1 Ω
35.63 ±
Slide
rheostat 0.1 Ω
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Connect the wire harness as shown in the illustration, and adjust the ammeter pointer to indicate ”0” using the slide rheostat,
then read the rheostat indication.
Temperature °C (°F)
Resistance (Ω)
50 (122.0)
160 – 240
120 (248.0)
17.1 – 21.2
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the engine coolant temperature sender gauge.
I07709
9.
(a)
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the warning switch and
ground terminal on the wire harness side connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
1
Z14205
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N06640
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Disconnect the connector from the switch.
Check that continuity exists between terminal and ground
with the engine stopped.
Check that no continuity exists between terminal and
ground with the engine running.
HINT:
Oil pressure should be over 24.5 kPa (0.25 kgf/cm2, 3.55 psi).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
SF–1
SFI (5S–FE)
–
SFI SYSTEM
SFI SYSTEM
SF0D6–04
PRECAUTION
1.
BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE FROM BATTERY
HINT:
Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be
erased when the negative (–) terminal cable is removed from
the battery.
Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before removing the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
2.
DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME
WHEN WORKING ON THE FUEL SYSTEM
3.
KEEP GASOLINE AWAY FROM RUBBER OR LEATHER PARTS
4.
MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS
(a) In event of engine misfire, these precautions should be
taken.
(1) Check proper connection to battery terminals, etc.
(2) After repair work, check that the ignition coil terminals and all other ignition system lines are reconnected securely.
(3) When cleaning the engine compartment, be especially careful to protect the electrical system from
water.
(b) Precautions when handling the oxygen sensor.
(1) Do not allow oxygen sensor to drop or hit against an
object.
(2) Do not allow the sensor to come into contact with
water.
5.
IF VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE RADIO SYSTEM (HAM, CB, ETC.)
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system,
refer to the precaution in the IN section.
6.
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Separation of the engine oil dipstick, oil filler cap, PCV
hose, etc. may cause the engine to run out of tune.
(b) Disconnection, looseness or cracks in the parts of the air
induction system between the throttle body and cylinder
head will allow air suction and cause the engine to run out
of tune.
7.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
(a) Before removing SFI wiring connectors, terminals, etc.,
first disconnect the power by either turning the ignition
switch OFF or disconnecting the negative (–) terminal
cable from the battery.
HINT:
Always check the diagnostic trouble code before disconnecting
the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
Author:
Date:
1434
SF–2
SFI (5S–FE)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
–
SFI SYSTEM
When installing the battery, be especially careful not to incorrectly connect the positive (+) and negative (–) cables.
Do not permit parts to receive a severe impact during removal or installation. Handle all SFI parts carefully, especially the ECM.
Be careful during troubleshooting as there are numerous
transistor circuit, and even slight terminal contact can
cause further troubles.
Do not open the ECM cover.
When inspecting during rainy weather, take care to prevent entry of water. Also, when washing the engine
compartment, prevent water from getting on the SFI parts
and wiring connectors.
Parts should be replaced as an assembly.
Care should be taken when pulling out and inserting wiring connectors.
(1) Release the lock and pull out the connector, pulling
on the connectors.
(2) Fully insert the connector and check that it is locked.
(i)
Use SST for inspection or test of the injector or its wiring
connector.
SST 09842–30070
8.
(a)
FUEL SYSTEM
When disconnecting the high fuel pressure line, a large
amount of gasoline will spill out, so observe these procedures:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
(2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on
its own, turn the ignition switch OFF.
SST
FI2553
Fuel
Pump
Connector
S04600
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
Plug
Put a container under the connection.
Slowly loosen the connection.
Disconnect the connection.
Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
Reconnect the fuel pump connector.
S05326
Author:
Date:
1435
SF–3
SFI (5S–FE)
(b)
–
SFI SYSTEM
When connecting the union bolt on the high pressure pipe
union, observe these procedures:
(1) Always use 2 new gaskets.
(2) Tighten the union bolt by hand.
(3) Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
New Gasket
S05523
(c)
SST
Fulcrum Length
30 cm
FI1654
O–Ring
When connecting the flare nut on the high pressure pipe
union, observe these procedures:
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut, and
tighten the flare nut by hand.
(2) Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque.
SST 09631–22020
NOTICE:
Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Torque: 28 N·m (285 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf) for using SST
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
(d)
CORRECT
Injector
Delivery Pipe
Grommet
WRONG
Observe these precautions when removing and installing
the injectors.
(1) Never reuse the O–ring.
(2) When placing a new O–ring on the injector, take
care not to damage it in any way.
(3) Coat a new O–ring with spindle oil or gasoline before installing–never use engine, gear or brake oil.
FI0420
Author:
Date:
1436
SF–4
SFI (5S–FE)
(e)
California
O–Ring
Insulator
Grommet
O–Ring
(f)
Injector
Except California
–
SFI SYSTEM
Install the injector to the delivery pipe and cylinder head,
as shown in the illustration.
Before installing the injector, must apply spindle oil or gasoline on the place where a delivery pipe or an intake manifold touches an O–ring of the injector.
Observe these precautions when disconnecting the fuel
tube connector (quick type):
(1) Check if there is any dirt like mud on the pipe and
around the connector before disconnecting them
and clean the dirt away.
(2) Be sure to disconnect with hands.
O–Ring
Insulator
Grommet
Injector
Z11336
(3)
Pull
(4)
When the connector and the pipe are stuck, pinch
the retainer between the hands, push and pull the
connector to free to disconnect and pull it out. Do
not use any tool at this time.
Inspect if there is any dirt or the likes on the seal surface of the disconnected pipe and clean it away.
S04583
(5)
Vinyl Bag
Prevent the disconnected pipe and connector from
damaging and mixing foreign objects by covering
them with a vinyl bag.
S05040
(g)
Retainer
Observe these precautions when connecting the fuel
tube connector (quick type):
(1) Do not reuse the retainer removed from the pipe.
(2) Must use hands without using tools when to remove
the retainer from the pipe.
(3) Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on
the connected part of the pipe.
S05382
Author:
Date:
1437
SF–5
SFI (5S–FE)
–
SFI SYSTEM
(4)
Click Sound
S05050
(h)
Match the axis of the connector with axis of the pipe,
and push in the connector until the retainer makes
a ”click” sound. In case that the connections is tight,
apply little amount of new engine oil on the tip of the
pipe.
(5) After having finished the connection, check if the
pipe and the connector are securely connected by
pulling them.
(6) Check if there is any fuel leakage.
Observe these precautions when handling nylon tube.
(1) Pay attention not to turn the connected part of the
nylon tube and the quick connector with force when
connecting them.
(2) Pay attention not to kink the nylon tube.
(3) Do not remove the EPDM protector on the outside
of the nylon tube.
(4) Must not close the piping with the nylon tube by
bending it.
(i)
S05331
Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance anywhere on the fuel system.
(1) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA
hand–held tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(3) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(4) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(5) If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, connect
the positive (+) and negative (–) leads from the battery to the fuel pump connector.
(See page SF–6)
(6) Check that there are no leaks from any part of the
fuel system.
(7) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(8) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
Author:
Date:
1438
SF–6
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
FUEL PUMP
SF0D7–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
S05331
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION
Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(d) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
(e) If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, connect the
positive (+) and negative (–) leads from the battery to the
fuel pump connector. (See step 7)
(f)
Fuel Inlet Hose
S05327
Check that there is pressure in the fuel inlet hose from the
fuel filter.
HINT:
If there is fuel pressure, you will hear the sound of fuel flowing.
If there is no pressure, check the fusible link, fuses, EFI main
relay, fuel pump, ECM and wiring connections.
(g) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(h) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
2.
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the battery positive voltage is above 12 V.
(b) Disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(c)
Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets, and disconnect the
fuel inlet hose from the fuel filter outlet.
CAUTION:
Put a shop towel under the fuel filter.
Slowly loosen the union bolt.
S05522
Author:
Date:
1439
SF–7
SFI (5S–FE)
Fuel Inlet
Hose
Gasket
S05328
Ohmmeter
4
FUEL PUMP
(d)
SST (Union Bolt)
SST
(Gauge)
Gasket
Gasket
SST (Union)
–
5
Install the fuel inlet hose and SST (pressure gauge) to the
fuel filter outlet with the 3 gaskets and SST (union bolt).
SST 09268–45014 (09268–41190, 90405–06167)
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
(e) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(f)
Reconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
(g) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(See step 1 in check fuel pump operation (a) to (e))
(h) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure:
301 – 347 kPa (3.1 – 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 – 50 psi)
If pressure is high, replace the fuel pressure regulator.
If pressure is low, check the fuel hoses, fuel hose connections,
fuel pump, fuel filter and fuel pressure regulator.
(i)
Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
(j)
Start the engine.
(k) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
301 – 347 kPa (3.1 – 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 – 50 psi)
(l)
Stop the engine.
(m) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5
minutes after the engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure:
147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified, check the fuel pump, pressure
regulator and/or injectors.
(n) After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the negative (–)
terminal cable from the battery and carefully remove the
SST to prevent gasoline from splashing.
SST 09268–45014
(o) Reconnect the fuel inlet hose with 2 new gaskets and the
union bolt.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
(p) Reconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
(q) Check for fuel leaks. (See page SF–1)
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
4.
REMOVE FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
5.
DISCONNECT FUEL PUMP & SENDER GAUGE CONNECTOR
6.
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals
4 and 5.
Resistance: 0.2 – 3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the fuel pump.
S04508
Author:
Date:
1440
SF–8
SFI (5S–FE)
4
Battery
5
S04509
–
FUEL PUMP
7.
INSPECT FUEL PUMP OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 4 of
the connector, and the negative (–) lead to terminal 5. Check
that the fuel pump operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be done quickly (within 10 seconds)
to prevent the coil burning out.
Keep the fuel pump as far away from the battery as
possible.
Always do the switching at the battery side.
If operation is not as specified, replace the fuel pump or lead
wire.
8.
RECONNECT FUEL PUMP & SENDER GAUGE CONNECTOR
9.
REINSTALL FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
10. REINSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION
Author:
Date:
1441
SF–9
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF0D8–02
COMPONENTS
Type A
Rear Seat Cushion
Floor Service Hole Cover
x8
4 (40, 35 in.·lbf)
Fuel Pump & Sender
Gauge Connector
No.1 Fuel Tank Protector
Fuel Tank Vent Tube Set Plate
Fuel Hose
Fuel Pump Assembly
Fuel Pump Connector
Fuel Pump
Gasket
Fuel Pump Filter
Clip
Rubber Cushion
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z19025
Author:
Date:
1442
SF–10
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
Type B
Rear Seat Cushion
Floor Service Hole
Cover
Fuel Pump & Sender
Gauge Connector
Fuel Sender Gauge
Connector
x8
Fuel Sender Gauge
4 (40, 35 in.·lbf)
No.1 Fuel Tank Protector
Fuel Pump Flange
Fuel Tank Vent Tube Set Plate
O–Ring
Fuel Filter
Ground
Plate
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump Assembly
Fuel Pump
Lead Wire
Housing
Gasket
Fuel Pump Filter
Clip
Rubber Cushion
”C” Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
S06038
Author:
Date:
1443
SF–11
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF0D9–03
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Do not smoke or work near an open flame when working on
the fuel pump.
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
2.
REMOVE FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Take out the floor carpet.
(b) Remove the service hole cover.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Check for fuel leakage.
3.
DISCONNECT FUEL PUMP & SENDER GAUGE CONNECTOR
4.
REMOVE NO.1 FUEL TANK PROTECTOR
Remove the 2 bolts and No.1 fuel tank protector.
Torque: 4 N·m (40 kgf·cm, 35 in.·lbf)
5.
S04583
DISCONNECT FUEL TUBE (FUEL TUBE CONNECTOR)
CAUTION:
Perform disconnecting and connecting operations of
the fuel tube connector (quick type) after observing
the precautions.
As there is retained pressure in the fuel pipe line, prevent it from splashing inside the vehicle compartment.
6.
(a)
Vinyl Bag
S04592
REMOVE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY FROM FUEL TANK
Remove the 6 bolts and fuel tank vent tube set plate.
Torque: 4 N·m (40 kgf·cm, 35 in.·lbf)
(b) Pull out the fuel pump assembly.
(c) Remove the gasket from the pump assembly.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel pump filter.
Be careful that the arm of the sender gauge should
not bent.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install a new gasket to the pump assembly.
Author:
Date:
1444
SF–12
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF0DA–02
DISASSEMBLY
Type B
1.
2.
3.
DISCONNECT FUEL PUMP CONNECTOR
Type B:
DISCONNECT GROUND PLATE
Type B:
DISCONNECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE CONNECTOR
S06028
4.
Type A
(a)
(b)
(c)
Pull
Type A:
REMOVE FUEL PUMP FROM FUEL PUMP BRACKET
Pull off the lower side of the fuel pump from the pump
bracket.
Disconnect the fuel hose from the fuel pump, and remove
the fuel pump.
Remove the rubber cushion from the fuel pump.
S04603
5.
Type B:
REMOVE FUEL SENDER GAUGE.
Push down the portion of A with a finger, and push up the sender gauge.
NOTICE:
Be careful that the arm of the sender gauge should not
bent.
Type B
A
Push
S06033
6.
Type B
S06050
(a)
(b)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items. Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring, and install it to the
fuel filter.
Torque: 2.0 N·m (20 kgf·cm, 17 in.·lbf)
7.
Type B:
REMOVE FUEL PUMP FLANGE
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap fit portion in the order of
1, 2 and 3 as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items. Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring of the fuel pump.
Type B
(2)
Type B:
REMOVE FUEL FILTER
Remove the screw, and pull out the fuel filter.
Remove the O–ring from the fuel filter.
(3)
(1)
S06030
Author:
Date:
1445
SF–13
SFI (5S–FE)
8.
Type B
–
FUEL PUMP
Type B:
REMOVE FUEL PUMP LEAD WIRE.
S06027
9.
Type B
(3)
(1)
(2)
Type B:
REMOVE ”C” BRACKET, RUBBER CUSHION AND
FUEL PUMP
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap fit portion in the order of
1, 2 and 3 as shown in the illustration.
S06029
10. REMOVE FUEL PUMP FILTER FROM FUEL PUMP
(a) Using a small screwdriver, remove the clip.
(b) Pull out the pump filter.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install the pump filter with a new clip.
FI6376
Author:
Date:
1446
SF–14
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF0DB–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly. (See page SF–12)
Author:
Date:
1447
SF–15
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF0DC–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page SF–11)
Author:
Date:
1448
SF–16
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
SF0DD–02
COMPONENTS
Type A
Rear Seat Cushion
Floor Service Hole Cover
x8
Fuel Pump & Sender
Gauge Connector
4 (40, 35 in.·lbf)
No.1 Fuel Tank Protector
Fuel Tank Vent Tube Set Plate
Fuel Pump Assembly
Gasket
Fuel Pressure
Regulator
O–Ring
O–Ring
Fuel Filter
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z19026
Author:
Date:
1449
SF–17
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
Type B
Rear Seat Cushion
Floor Service Hole Cover
x8
Fuel Pump and Sender
Gauge Connector
4 (40, 35 in.·lbf)
No.1 Fuel Tank Protector
Fuel Tank Vent Tube Set Plate
Fuel Pump Assembly
Gasket
Fuel Pressure
Regulator
O–Ring
O–Ring
Fuel Filter
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
S06037
Author:
Date:
1450
SF–18
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
SF0DE–03
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY FROM FUEL TANK
(See page SF–11)
2.
REMOVE FUEL FILTER
(a) Remove the screw, and pull out the fuel filter.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the fuel filter.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items. Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring, and install it to the
fuel filter.
Torque: 2.0 N·m (20 kgf·cm, 17 in.·lbf)
S04591
3.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
Remove the screw, and pull out the pressure regulator.
Torque: 2.0 N·m (20 kgf·cm, 17 in.·lbf)
Remove the O–ring from the pressure regulator.
(b)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items. Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring, and install it to the
pressure regulator.
S04590
Author:
Date:
1451
SF–19
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
SF0DF–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page SF–18)
Author:
Date:
1452
SF–20
SFI (5S–FE)
–
INJECTOR
INJECTOR
SF0DG–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT INJECTOR OPERATION
Check operation sound from each injector.
(a) With the engine running or cranking, use a sound scope
to check that there is a normal operating noise in proportion to engine speed.
Sound
Scope
S05304
(b)
If you have no sound scope, you can check the injector
transmission operation with your finger.
If no sound or unusual sound is heard, check the wiring connector, injector or injection signal from the ECM.
S05305
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT INJECTOR RESISTANCE
Disconnect the injector connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the
terminals.
Resistance: 13.4 – 14.2 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the injector.
(c) Reconnect the injector connector.
Ohmmeter
S05306
Author:
Date:
1453
SF–21
SFI (5S–FE)
–
INJECTOR
SF0DH–03
COMPONENTS
High–Tension Cord
44 (450, 33)
Grommet
Cylinder Head
Cover
PCV Hose
PCV Hose
Gasket
Injector
(Except California)
Injector
(California)
13 (130, 9)
Injector
Connector
Delivery Pipe
Insulator
Insulator
O–Ring
O–Ring
Grommet
Engine Wire
Clamp
Spacer
Spacer
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
S05925
Author:
Date:
1454
SF–22
SFI (5S–FE)
–
INJECTOR
SF0DI–03
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER
Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the clamps on
the cylinder head cover.
Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the spark
plugs.
(c)
(d)
(e)
Disconnect the PCV hose from the intake manifold.
Disconnect the PCV hose from the cylinder head cover.
Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the mounting bolt
of the No.2 timing belt cover.
(f)
Remove the cylinder head cover. (See page EM–33)
NOTICE:
Cover the cylinder head with a clean cloth to prevent dirt,
etc. getting into the cylinder head.
(c)
(e)
(d)
S05289
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE DELIVERY PIPE AND INJECTORS
Disconnect the 4 injector connectors.
Remove the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to the cylinder head.
B06353
B06354
(c) Disconnect the delivery pipe from the 4 injectors.
(d) Pull out the 4 injectors.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the injectors.
(e) Remove the 4 insulators (Except California) and 2
spacers from the cylinder head.
(f)
California:
Remove the 2 O–rings, insulator and grommet from each
injector.
(g) Except California:
Remove the O–ring and grommet from each injector.
Author:
Date:
1455
SF–23
SFI (5S–FE)
–
INJECTOR
SF0DJ–03
SST (Hose)
INSPECTION
Union Bolt
SST (Union)
Fuel Filter
(On Vehicle)
SST
(Clamp)
SST
(Union)
Injector
1.
INSPECT INJECTOR INJECTION
CAUTION:
Keep injector clean of sparks during the test.
S05525
(a)
Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets, and disconnect the
fuel inlet hose from the fuel filter outlet.
(b)
Connect SST (union and hose) to the fuel filter outlet with
the 2 gaskets and union bolts.
SST 09268–41047 (90405–09015)
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
S05522
Union Bolt
SST (Union)
Gasket
SST (Hose)
S05524
SST (Hose)
SST (Union)
O–Ring
SST
(Clamp)
Vinyl
Tube
(c)
(d)
Install the grommet and O–ring to the injector.
Connect SST (union and hose) to the injector, and hold
the injector and union with SST (clamp).
SST 09268–41047 (09268–41100, 09268–41110)
(e) Put the injector into the graduated cylinder.
CAUTION:
Install a suitable vinyl hose onto the injector to prevent
gasoline from splashing out.
P01078
(f)
(g)
(h)
S05331
Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Connect the battery negative (–) cable to the battery.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(i)
Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(j)
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
Author:
Date:
1456
SF–24
SFI (5S–FE)
(k)
–
INJECTOR
If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, connect the
positive (+) and negative (–) leads from the battery to the
fuel pump connector. (See page SF–6)
(l)
Connect SST (wire) to the injector and battery for 15 seconds, and measure the injection volume with a graduated cylinder. Test each injector 2 or 3 times.
SST 09842–30070
Volume: 51 – 63 cm3 (3.2 – 3.8 cu in.) per 15 seconds
Difference between each injector:
12 cm3 (0.7 cu in.) or less
If the injection volume is not as specified, replace the injector.
SST
(Wire)
Connect
P01077
California
Except California
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Z09211
(d)
(e)
(f)
INSPECT LEAKAGE
In the condition above, disconnect the tester probes of
SST (wire) from the battery and check the fuel leakage
from the injector.
SST 09842–30070
Fuel drop: 1 drop or less per 3 minutes
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
Remove the SST.
SST 09268–41047, 09842–30070
Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
Reconnect the fuel inlet hose to the fuel filter outlet with
2 new gaskets and the union bolt.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
S05522
Author:
Date:
1457
SF–25
SFI (5S–FE)
–
INJECTOR
SF0Z8–01
INSTALLATION
California
New Insulator
1.
(a)
New O–Ring
New O–Ring
(b)
(c)
New Grommet
(d)
Except California
INSTALL INJECTORS AND DELIVERY PIPE
California:
Install new insulator and grommet to each injector.
Except California:
Install a new grommet to each injector.
California:
Apply a light coat of gasoline onto 2 new O–rings, and
install them to each injector.
Except California:
Apply a light coat of gasoline onto a new O–ring, and
install it to each injector.
New
O–Ring
New Grommet
Z09141
(e)
Install the 2 spacers and 4 new insulators to the cylinder
head.
(f)
While turning the injector left and right, install it to the delivery pipe. Install the 4 injectors.
Position the injector connector upward.
Spacer
New Insulator
Spacer
S05980
Upward
(g)
Connector
Turn
Push
S05978
Author:
Date:
1458
SF–26
SFI (5S–FE)
(h)
(i)
–
INJECTOR
Attach the 4 injectors and delivery pipe assembly to the
cylinder head.
Temporarily install the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to
the cylinder head.
B06352
(j)
Check that the injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT:
If injectors do not rotate smoothly, the probable cause is incorrect installation of O–rings. Replace the O–rings.
(k) Position the injector connector upward.
(l)
Tighten the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to the cylinder
head.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Upward
Connector
Turn
S05976
No.1
(m) Connect the 4 injector connectors.
HINT:
The No.1 and No.3 injector connectors are brown, and the No.2
and No.4 injector connectors are gray.
Gray
No.2
No.3
Brown
No.4
B06351
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(b)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(c)
S05289
3.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER
Install the cylinder head cover. (See page EM–53)
Connect the PCV hose to the intake manifold.
Connect the PCV hose to the cylinder head cover.
Install the engine wire clamp to the mounting bolt of the
No.2 timing belt cover.
Connect the 4 high–tension cords to the spark plugs.
Install the 4 high–tension cords to the clamps on the cylinder head cover.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page SF–1)
Author:
Date:
1459
SF–27
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL TANK AND LINE
FUEL TANK AND LINE
SF0DL–03
COMPONENTS
CAUTION:
Always use new gaskets when replacing the fuel tank or component parts.
Apply the proper torque to all parts tightened
Location of Fuel Tank Cushion
No.1 Fuel Tank
Protector
x8
Fuel Tank Vent
Tube Set Plate
Fuel Pump
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
HINT:
Before installing the heated oxygen sensor,
twist the sensor wire counterclockwise
3 and 1/2 turns.
After installing the heated oxygen sensor,
check that the sensor wire is not twisted,
if it is twisted, remove the heated oxygen
sensor and reinstall it.
Charcoal
Canister
Fuel Inlet Pipe Shield
Fuel Tank Cap
Vent Line Hose
Gasket
Fuel Outlet Tube
Gasket
EVAP Line Hose
Fuel Inlet Pipe
Fuel Inlet Hose
Fuel Tank
Fuel Inlet Pipe Protector
39 (400, 29)
Gasket
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Fuel Tank Band
Heat Insulator
44 (450, 33)
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Center Exhaust Pipe
56 (570, 41)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06469
Author:
Date:
1460
SF–28
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL TANK AND LINE
SF0DM–03
INSPECTION
Crack
Leakage
Deformation
BO0919
SST
Use SST
28 N·m
(285 kgf·cm, 21ft·lbf)
SST: 09631–22020
INSPECT FUEL TANK AND LINE
(a) Check the fuel lines for cracks or leakage, and all connections for deformation.
(b) Check the fuel tank vapor vent system hoses and connections for looseness, sharp bends or damage.
(c) Check the fuel tank for deformation, cracks, fuel leakage
or tank band looseness.
(d) Check the filler neck for damage or fuel leakage.
(e) Hose and pipe connections are as shown in the illustration.
If a problem is found, repair or replace the parts as necessary.
Fulcrum
Length
30 cm
(11.81 in.)
Z10162
2 – 7 mm (0.08 – 0.28 in.)
Hose
Pipe
Clip
0 – 3 mm (0 – 0.12 in.)
FU0041
Author:
Date:
1461
SF–29
SFI (5S–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
THROTTLE BODY
SF0DN–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
Move
1.
(a)
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY
Check that the throttle linkage moves smoothly.
(b)
Check the vacuum at each port.
Start the engine.
Check the vacuum with your finger.
B01277
P
Port name
R
E
At idle
Other than idle
Mark E
Vacuum
Vacuum
Mark P
No vacuum
Vacuum
Mark R
No vacuum
No vacuum
B00525
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the sensor connector.
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle opener.
Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
(d)
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
each terminal.
Disconnect
Vacuum
B01278
VTA
E2
VC
Ohmmeter
B01282
(e)
(f)
3.
(a)
Clearance between
lever and stop screw
Between
terminals
Resistance
0 mm (0 in.)
VTA – E2
0.2 – 5.7 kΩ
Throttle valve fully
open
VTA – E2
2.0 – 10.2 kΩ
–
VC – E2
2.5 – 5.9 kΩ
Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle opener.
Reconnect the sensor connector.
INSPECT THROTTLE OPENER
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
Author:
Date:
1462
SF–30
SFI (5S–FE)
(b)
(c)
S05331
(d)
Plug
Disconnect
–
THROTTLE BODY
Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII scan tool.
(1) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument panel.
(2) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII
scan tool to the DLC3.
(3) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester or
OBDII scan tool operator’s manual for further details.
Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
Check and adjust the throttle opener setting speed.
(1) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle opener, and plug the hose end.
(2) Maintain the engine speed at 2,500 rpm.
(3) Release the throttle valve.
(4) Check that the throttle opener is set.
Throttle opener setting speed:
1,300 – 1,500 rpm (w/ Cooling fan OFF)
B01279
(5)
2.5 mm Hexagon Wrench
(e)
Using a 2.5 mm hexagon wrench, loosen the lock
nut and adjust the throttle opener setting speed by
turning the throttle opener adjusting screw. Tighten
the lock nut.
(6) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle opener.
Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII scan
tool.
B01280
Author:
Date:
1463
SF–31
SFI (5S–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
SF0DO–03
COMPONENTS
Vacuum Hose
19 (195, 14)
Gasket
Accelerator Cable
Throttle Cable
(A/T)
Throttle Position Sensor
Connector
Throttle Body
IAC Valve Connector
Water Bypass Hose
Air Hose
(California)
EVAP Hose
EVAP Hose
Air Cleaner Hose
EVAP Hose
PCV Hose
IAT Sensor
Connector
Air Cleaner Cap
VSV Connector
for EVAP
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B00526
Author:
Date:
1464
SF–32
SFI (5S–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
SF0DP–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP (See page EM–69)
DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE FROM
THROTTLE BODY
A/T:
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE FROM THROTTLE
BODY
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the throttle body.
(d)
(e)
(f)
Remove the 3 bolts.
Disconnect the throttle body from the intake manifold.
Remove the gasket.
(g)
Disconnect the air hose for air assist system (California)
and the 2 water bypass hoses from the throttle body, and
remove the throttle body.
4.
B01283
Water
Bypass
Hose
Air
Hose
Water
Bypass
Hose
S05534
Author:
Date:
1465
SF–33
SFI (5S–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
SF0DQ–03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
B00527
Throttle
Lever
Stop
Screw
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
No
Clearance
Disconnect
Vacuum
CLEAN THROTTLE BODY
Using a soft brush and carburetor cleaner, clean the cast
parts.
(b) Using compressed air, clean all the passages and apertures.
NOTICE:
To prevent deterioration, do not clean the throttle position
sensor and throttle opener.
(d)
B01284
3.
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY
Disconnect the throttle opener vacuum hose from the
throttle body.
Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
Check that there is no clearance between the throttle stop
screw and throttle lever when the throttle valve is fully
closed.
Reconnect the throttle opener vacuum hose to the throttle
body.
INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
(See page SF–29)
Author:
Date:
1466
SF–34
SFI (5S–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
SF0DR–03
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(c)
(b)
S05534
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
2.
3.
B01283
4.
5.
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY
Connect the water bypass hose (from the water bypass
pipe) to the throttle body.
Connect the water bypass hose (from the water outlet) to
the throttle body.
California:
Connect the air hose (from the intake manifold) for air assist system to the throttle body.
Install a new gasket and the throttle body with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Connect the 2 vacuum hoses to the throttle body.
Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
Connect the IAC valve connector.
CONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE TO THROTTLE
BODY
A/T:
CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE TO THROTTLE BODY
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP (See page EM–75)
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Author:
Date:
1467
SF–35
SFI (5S–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF0DS–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
TE1
INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
Initial conditions:
Engine at normal operating temperature
Idle speed set correctly
Transmission in neutral position
(b)
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(c) After the engine speed is kept at 900 – 1,300 rpm for 5 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed.
If the engine speed operation is not as specified, check the IAC
valve, wiring and ECM.
(d) Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
E1
SST
A07370
Ohmmeter
+B
ISCC
ISCO
B01281
2.
INSPECT IAC VALVE RESISTANCE
NOTICE:
”Cold” and ”Hot” in these sentences express the temperature of the coils themselves. ”Cold” is from –10°C (14°F) to
50°C (122°F) and ”Hot” is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C
(212°F).
(a) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminal +B and other terminals (ISCC, ISCO).
Resistance:
Cold
17.0 – 24.5 Ω
Hot
21.5 – 28.5 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
(c) Reconnect the IAC valve connector.
Author:
Date:
1468
SF–36
SFI (5S–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF0DT–03
COMPONENTS
Vacuum Hose
Gasket
Accelerator Cable
Throttle Cable
(A/T)
Throttle Position Sensor
Connector
Throttle Body
Water Bypass Hose
Air Hose (California)
IAC Valve Connector
19 (195, 14)
EVAP Hose
EVAP Hose
Air Cleaner Hose
EVAP Hose
Throttle Body
PCV Hose
IAT Sensor
Connector
Gasket
IAC Valve
Air Cleaner Cap
VSV Connector
for EVAP
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B01285
Author:
Date:
1469
SF–37
SFI (5S–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF0DU–03
REMOVAL
1.
Except California
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY (See page SF–32)
2.
REMOVE IAC VALVE
Remove the 4 screws, IAC valve and gasket.
B01276
Author:
Date:
1470
SF–38
SFI (5S–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF0DV–03
INSPECTION
INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
+B and negative (–) lead to terminal ISCC, and check that
the valve is closed.
Battery
ISCC
Closed
+B
S01477
(b)
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
+B and negative (–) lead to terminal ISCO, and check that
the valve is open.
If operation is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
Battery
Open
+B
ISCO
S01478
Author:
Date:
1471
SF–39
SFI (5S–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF0DW–03
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
INSTALL IAC VALVE
Place a new gasket on the throttle body.
Install the IAC valve with the 4 screws.
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY (See page SF–34)
New
Gasket
B01275
Author:
Date:
1472
SF–40
SFI (5S–FE)
–
EFI MAIN RELAY
EFI MAIN RELAY
SF0DX–03
INSPECTION
EFI Main
Relay
1.
2.
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI)
S05392
3.
(a)
Continuity
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
2
1
5
3
No Continuity
INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
Inspect the relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
3 and 5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
S04970
(b)
2
Ohmmeter
1
5
3
Battery
Continuity
Inspect the relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
4.
REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
5.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
S04969
Author:
Date:
1473
SF–41
SFI (5S–FE)
Circuit Opening
Relay
–
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
SF0DY–03
INSPECTION
1.
2.
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
REMOVE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY (Marking: CIR
OPN)
S05389
Continuity
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
2
1
5
3
No Continuity
3.
(a)
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
Inspect the relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
3 and 5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
S04970
(b)
2
Ohmmeter
1
5
3
Battery
Continuity
Inspect the relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
4.
REINSTALL CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
5.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
S04969
Author:
Date:
1474
SF–42
SFI (5S–FE)
–
VSV FOR EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR)
VSV FOR EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR)
SF0DZ–03
COMPONENTS
VSV Connector for EGR
Vacuum Hose
VSV for EGR
B06348
Author:
Date:
1475
SF–43
SFI (5S–FE)
–
VSV FOR EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR)
SF0E0–03
INSPECTION
1.
Ohmmeter
REMOVE VSV
2.
(a)
INSPECT VSV
Inspect the VSV for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the terminals.
Resistance: 33 – 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
Continuity
S05259
Ohmmeter
(b)
Inspect the VSV for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
No Continuity
S05260
(c)
Air
Inspect the VSV operation.
(1) Check that air flows from ports E to G.
E
G
S05261
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that air flows from port E to filter.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3.
REINSTALL VSV
Air
Battery
E
Filter
S05262
Author:
Date:
1476
SF–44
SFI (5S–FE)
–
VSV FOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
VSV FOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
SF0E1–03
COMPONENTS
VSV for EVAP
VSV Connector
for EVAP
EVAP Hose
S05276
Author:
Date:
1477
SF–45
SFI (5S–FE)
–
VSV FOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
SF0E2–03
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE VSV
2.
(a)
INSPECT VSV
Inspect the VSV for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the terminals.
Resistance: 30 – 34 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
S05263
(b)
Inspect the VSV for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
S05264
(c)
Inspect the VSV operation.
(1) Check that air dose not flow from ports E to F.
NOTICE:
Never apply more than 93 kPa (0.95 kgf/cm2, 13.5 psi) of
pressure compressed air to the VSV.
Air
E
F
S05265
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that air flows from ports E to F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3.
REINSTALL VSV
Air
E
F
Battery
S05266
Author:
Date:
1478
SF–46
SFI (5S–FE)
–
VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF0E3–03
COMPONENTS
VSV for Vapor Pressure
Sensor Connector
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Hose
Charcoal Canister
B06550
Author:
Date:
1479
SF–47
SFI (5S–FE)
–
VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF0E4–04
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE VSV
2.
(a)
INSPECT VSV
Inspect the VSV for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the terminals.
Resistance: 33 – 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
B01273
(b)
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
Inspect the VSV for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
B00798
(c)
Air
Inspect the VSV operation.
(1) Check that air flows from ports E to G.
E
G
B00799
(2) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that air flows from ports E to F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3.
REINSTALL VSV
Air
E
F
Battery
B00800
Author:
Date:
1480
SF–48
SFI (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
SF0E5–03
COMPONENTS
ECT Sensor Connector
ECT Sensor
Gasket
Non–reusable part
B06361
Author:
Date:
1481
SF–49
SFI (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
SF0E6–03
INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
4.
REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
5.
REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
Ohmmeter
30
20
Resistance kΩ
10
5
3
2
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
REMOVE ECT SENSOR
Acceptable
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
–20
0
20 40 60 80 100
(–4) (32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
S01196
S01699
Temperature °C (°F)
Z17274
Author:
Date:
1482
SF–50
SFI (5S–FE)
–
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
SF0E7–03
COMPONENTS
Grommet
IAT Sensor
IAT Sensor Connector
S05277
Author:
Date:
1483
SF–51
SFI (5S–FE)
–
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
SF0E8–03
INSPECTION
1.
2.
INSPECT IAT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
3.
REINSTALL IAT SENSOR
Resistance kΩ
Ohmmeter
30
20
10
5
3
2
REMOVE IAT SENSOR
Acceptable
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
–20 0 20 40 60 80 100
(–4)(32)(68)(104)(140)(176)(212)
Temperature °C (°F)
Z17273
Author:
Date:
1484
SF–52
SFI (5S–FE)
–
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
SF0E9–03
COMPONENTS
MAP Sensor and Bracket Assembly
MAP Sensor
Vacuum Hose
MAP Sensor
Connector
Wire Clamp
B00528
Author:
Date:
1485
SF–53
SFI (5S–FE)
–
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
SF0EA–03
Ohmmeter
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Disconnect
E2
VC
S05545
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Disconnect
(d)
Vacuum
w/o Immobilizer
ECM
(d)
(e)
PIM
(e)
INSPECT POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE OF MAP SENSOR
Disconnect the MAP sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between connector terminals VC and E2 of the wiring harness side.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Reconnect the MAP sensor connector.
INSPECT POWER OUTPUT OF MAP SENSOR
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the MAP sensor.
Connect a voltmeter to terminals PIM and E2 of the ECM,
and measure the output voltage under ambient atmospheric pressure.
Apply vacuum to the MAP sensor in 13.3 kPa (100 mmHg,
3.94 in.Hg) segments to 66.7 kPa (500 mmHg, 19.69
in.Hg).
Measure the voltage drop from step (c) above for each
segment.
Voltage Drop:
Voltmeter
Applied
Vacuum
kPa
mmHg
in.Hg
E2
Voltage
drop V
w/ Immobiliser
ECM
PIM (+)
A03009
(f)
(g)
E2 (–)
13.3
26.7
40.0
53.5
66.7
100
3.94
200
7.87
300
11.81
400
15.75
500
19.69
0.3 – 0.5 0.7 – 0.9 1.1 – 1.3 1.5 – 1.7 1.9 – 2.1
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Reconnect the vacuum hose to the MAP sensor.
B01912
Author:
Date:
1486
SF–54
SFI (5S–FE)
–
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF0EF–04
COMPONENTS
Vapor Pressure Sensor
(Type B)
Vapor Pressure Sensor
(Type A)
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Connector
Vacuum hose
Charcoal Canister
B06554
Author:
Date:
1487
SF–55
SFI (5S–FE)
–
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF0EG–03
INSPECTION
Voltmeter
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Disconnect
VC
E2
B06551
(d)
(e)
2.
Type A
(a)
(b)
Pressure
Vacuum
(c)
Disconnect
Type B
Disconnect
Pressure
P
Vacuum
w/o Immobiliser
ECM
PTNK E2
(d)
(e)
Voltmeter
w/ Immobiliser
PTNK (+)
ECM
B06552
B06553
S05603
A03018
INSPECT POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE OF VAPOR
PRESSURE SENSOR
Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between connector terminals VC and E2 of the wiring harness side.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Reconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
INSPECT POWER OUTPUT OF VAPOR PRESSURE
SENSOR
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure
sensor.
Connect a voltmeter to terminals PTNK and E2 of the
ECM, and measure the output voltage under the following
conditions:
(1) Apply vacuum (2.0 kPa (15 mmHg, 0.59 in.Hg)) to
the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 1.3 – 2.1 V
(2) Release the vacuum from the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 3.0 – 3.6 V
(3) Apply pressure (1.5 kPa (15 gf/cm2, 0.22 psi)) to the
vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 4.2 – 4.8 V
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Reconnect the vacuum hose to the vapor pressure sensor.
E2 (–)
B06570
Author:
Date:
1488
SF–56
SFI (5S–FE)
–
KNOCK SENSOR
KNOCK SENSOR
SF0ED–03
COMPONENTS
Knock sensor 1
Knock Sensor 1 Connector
B06349
Author:
Date:
1489
SF–57
SFI (5S–FE)
–
KNOCK SENSOR
SF0EE–03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
SST
Ohmmeter
REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR 1
Disconnect the knock sensor connector.
Using SST, remove the knock sensor.
SST 09816–30010
B06350
No Continuity
P01630
2.
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR 1
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between
the terminal and body.
If there is continuity, replace the sensor.
3.
REINSTALL KNOCK SENSOR 1
(a) Using SST, install the knock sensor.
SST 09816–30010
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the knock sensor connector.
Author:
Date:
1490
SF–58
SFI (5S–FE)
–
AIR–FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR (California)
AIR–FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR (California)
SF0EB–03
COMPONENTS
No.3 Exhaust Manifold Heat Insulator
A/F Sensor Connector
Clamp
A/F Sensor
44 (450, 32)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
B06358
Author:
Date:
1491
SF–59
SFI (5S–FE)
–
AIR–FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR (California)
SF0EC–04
INSPECTION
+B
Ohmmeter
HT
B06365
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF A/F SENSOR
Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals +B and HT.
Resistance: 0.8 – 1.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
2.
INSPECT OPERATION OF A/F SENSOR
(See page DI–152)
Author:
Date:
1492
SF–60
SFI (5S–FE)
–
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank 1 Sensor 1/Except
Calif.)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank 1 Sensor 1/Except Calif.)
SF0EH–03
COMPONENTS
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1) Connector
Clamp
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
44 (450, 32)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
B06359
Author:
Date:
1493
SFI (5S–FE)
–
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank 1 Sensor 1/Except
Calif.)
SF–61
SF0EI–03
INSPECTION
+B
1.
Ohmmeter
HT
B06363
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals +B and HT.
Resistance: 11 – 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(c) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
2.
INSPECT OPERATION OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (See page DI–66)
Author:
Date:
1494
SF–62
SFI (5S–FE)
–
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
SF0EJ–03
COMPONENTS
Passenger’s Seat
37 (375, 27)
Connector
for Seat
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
44 (450, 32)
Clamp
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Connector
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Grommet
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Z19284
Author:
Date:
1495
SF–63
SFI (5S–FE)
–
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
SF0EK–03
Ohmmeter
INSPECTION
1.
+B
HT
S05303
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals +B and HT.
Resistance: 11 – 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(c) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
2.
INSPECT OPERATION OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (See page DI–75)
Author:
Date:
1496
SF–64
SFI (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM)
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM)
SF0EL–03
COMPONENTS
No.2 Instrument Lower Panel
ECM
ECM Connector
Under Cover
Cowl Side Trim
Front Door Inside Scuff Plate
S06018
Author:
Date:
1497
SF–65
SFI (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM)
SF0EM–03
INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE ECM
INSPECT ECM (See page DI–22)
REINSTALL ECM
Author:
Date:
1498
SF–66
SFI (5S–FE)
–
FUEL CUT RPM
FUEL CUT RPM
SF0EN–03
INSPECTION
1.
WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
CONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR OBDII
SCAN TOOL
Remove the fuse cover on the instrument panel.
Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII scan tool
to the DLC3.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII
scan tool operator’s manual for further details.
S05331
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Sound
Scope
S05304
INSPECT FUEL CUT RPM OPERATION
Increase the engine speed to at least 2,500 rpm.
Check for injector operating noise.
Check that when the throttle lever is released, injector operation noise stops momentarily and then resumes.
HINT:
Measure with the A/C OFF.
Fuel return speed: 1,500 rpm
4.
DISCONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR
OBDII SCAN TOOL
Author:
Date:
1499
SF–1
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
SFI SYSTEM
SFI SYSTEM
SF078–03
PRECAUTION
1.
BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM,
DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
HINT:
Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be
erased when the negative (–) terminal cable is removed from
the battery.
Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before removing the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
2.
DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME
WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM
3.
KEEP GASOLINE AWAY FROM RUBBER OR
LEATHER PARTS
4.
MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS
(a) In event of engine misfire, these precautions should be
taken.
(1) Check proper connection to battery terminals, etc.
(2) After repair work, check that the ignition coil terminals and all other ignition system lines are reconnected securely.
(3) When cleaning the engine compartment, be especially careful to protect the electrical system from
water.
(b) Precautions when handling the oxygen sensor.
(1) Do not allow the oxygen sensor to drop or hit
against an object.
(2) Do not allow the sensor to come into contact with
water.
5.
IF VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH A MOBILE RADIO
SYSTEM (HAM, CB, ETC.)
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system,
refer to the precaution in the IN section.
6.
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Separation of the engine oil dipstick, oil filler cap, PCV
hose, etc. may cause the engine to run out of tune.
(b) Disconnection, looseness or cracks in the parts of the air
induction system between the throttle body and cylinder
head will allow air suction and cause the engine to run out
of tune.
7.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
(a) Before removing SFI wiring connectors, terminals, etc.,
first disconnect the power by either turning the ignition
switch to LOCK or disconnecting the negative (–) terminal
cable from the battery.
HINT:
Always check the diagnostic trouble code before disconnecting
the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
Author:
Date:
1500
SF–2
SFI (1MZ–FE)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
–
SFI SYSTEM
When installing the battery, be especially careful not to incorrectly connect the positive (+) and negative (–) cables.
Do not permit parts to receive a severe impact during removal or installation. Handle all SFI parts carefully, especially the ECM.
Be careful during troubleshooting as there are numerous
transistor circuit, and even slight terminal contact can
cause further troubles.
Do not open the ECM cover.
When inspecting during rainy weather, take care to prevent entry of water. Also, when washing the engine
compartment, prevent water from getting on the SFI parts
and wiring connectors.
Parts should be replaced as an assembly.
Care should be taken when pulling out and inserting wiring connectors.
(1) Release the lock and pull out the connector, pulling
on the connectors.
(2) Fully insert the connector and check that it is locked.
(i)
Use SST for inspection or test of the injector or its wiring
connector.
SST 09842–30070
8.
(a)
FUEL SYSTEM
When disconnecting the high fuel pressure line, a large
amount of gasoline will spill out, so observe these procedures:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
(2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on
its own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
SST
FI2553
Fuel
Pump
Connector
S04600
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Plug
Put a container under the connection.
Slowly loosen the connection.
Disconnect the connection.
Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
S05039
Author:
Date:
1501
SF–3
SFI (1MZ–FE)
(b)
–
SFI SYSTEM
When connecting the union bolt on the high pressure pipe
union, observe these procedures:
(1) Always use 2 new gaskets.
(2) Tighten the union bolt by hand.
(3) Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 32.5 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
New Gasket
S05054
(c)
Fulcrum Length
30 cm
SST
FI1654
New O–Ring
CORRECT
Grommet
Injector
WRONG
When connecting the flare nut on the high pressure pipe
union, observe these procedures:
(1) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut, and
tighten the flare nut by hand.
(2) Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque.
SST 09631–22020
NOTICE:
Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Torque: 28 N·m (285 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf) for using SST
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
(d)
Observe these precautions when removing and installing
the injectors.
(1) Never reuse the O–ring.
(2) When placing a new O–ring on the injector, take
care not to damage it in any way.
(3) Coat a new O–ring with spindle oil or gasoline before installing–never use engine, gear or brake oil.
FI6372
FI6372
Author:
Date:
1502
SF–4
SFI (1MZ–FE)
California A/T
Delivery Pipe
–
SFI SYSTEM
(e)
Install the injector to the delivery pipe and intake manifold,
as shown in the illustration.
Before installing the injector, must apply spindle oil or gasoline on the place where a delivery pipe or an intake manifold touches an O–ring of the injector.
(f)
Observe these precautions when disconnecting the fuel
tube connector (quick type).
(1) Check if there is any dirt like mud on the pipe and
around the connector before disconnecting them
and clean the dirt away.
(2) Be sure to disconnect with hands.
O–Ring
Insulator
Grommet
Spacer
O–Ring
Except California A/T
Delivery Pipe
O–Ring
Insulator
Grommet
Spacer
O–Ring
B00630
(3)
(4)
When the connector and the pipe are stuck, pinch
the retainer between the hands, push and pull the
connector to free to disconnect and pull it out. Do
not use any tool at this time.
Inspect if there is any dirt or the likes on the seal surface of the disconnected pipe and clean it away.
S04583
(5)
Vinyl Bag
Prevent the disconnected pipe and connector from
damaging and mixing foreign objects by covering
them with a vinyl bag.
S05040
Author:
Date:
1503
SF–5
SFI (1MZ–FE)
(g)
Retainer
–
SFI SYSTEM
Observe these precautions when connecting the fuel
tube connector (quick type).
(1) Do not reuse the retainer removed from the pipe.
(2) Must use hands without using tools when to remove
the retainer from the pipe.
(3) Check if there is any damage or foreign objects on
the connected part of the pipe.
S05382
(4)
Click Sound
(5)
(6)
S05050
(h)
TOYOTA
Hand–Held Tester
S05358
Match the axis of the connector with axis of the pipe,
and push in the connector until the retainer makes
a ”click” sound. In case that the connections is tight,
apply little amount of new engine oil on the tip of the
pipe.
After having finished the connection, check if the
pipe and the connector are securely connected by
pulling them.
Check if there is any fuel leakage.
Observe these precautions when handling nylon tube.
(1) Pay attention not to turn the connected part of the
nylon tube and the quick connector with force when
connecting them.
(2) Pay attention not to kink the nylon tube.
(3) Do not remove the EPDM protector on the outside
of the nylon tube.
(4) Must not close the piping with the nylon tube by
bending it.
(i)
Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance anywhere on the fuel system.
(1) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA
hand–held tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(3) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(4) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s manual for further details.
(5) If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, connect
the positive (+) and negative (–) leads from the battery to the fuel pump connector.
(See page SF–6)
(6) Check that there are no leaks from any part of the
fuel system.
(7) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(8) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
Author:
Date:
1504
SF–6
SFI (1MZ–FE)
TOYOTA
Hand Held Tester
–
FUEL PUMP
FUEL PUMP
SF079–04
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
S05358
CHECK FUEL PUMP OPERATION
Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(d) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
(e) If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, connect the
positive (+) and negative (–) leads from the battery to the
fuel pump connector. (See step 7)
(f)
S05353
HINT:
If there is fuel pressure, you will hear the sound of fuel flowing.
If there is no pressure, check these parts:
Fusible link
Fuses
EFI main relay
Fuel pump
ECM
Wiring connections
(g) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(h) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
2.
(a)
(b)
Fuel Tube Connector
Check that there is pressure in the fuel inlet hose from the
fuel filter.
(c)
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
Check the battery positive voltage is above 12 V.
Disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
Purchase the new No.1 fuel pipe and take out the fuel
tube connector from its pipe.
Part No. 23801–20041
S05359
Author:
Date:
1505
SF–7
SFI (1MZ–FE)
(d)
–
FUEL PUMP
Remove the fuel hose clamp.
Fuel Hose
Clamp
S06086
(e)
S05352
Disconnect the No.1 fuel pipe (fuel tube connector) from
the fuel filter outlet.
CAUTION:
Perform disconnecting operations of the fuel tube
connector (quick type) after observing the precautions. (See page SF–1)
As there is retained pressure in the fuel pipe line, prevent it from splashing inside the engine compartment.
(f)
SST
(Hose)
SST
Retainer
No.1 Fuel
Pipe
SST
Fuel Tube
Connector
SST
(Hose)
S05364
Install SST (pressure gauge) as shown in the illustration
by using SST and fuel tube connector.
SST 09268–41047, 09268–41250, 09268–45012
(g) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(h) Reconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
(i)
Connect the TOYOTA hand held tester to the DLC3.
(See step 1. check fuel pump operation (a) to (e))
(j)
Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure:
301 – 347 kPa (3.1 – 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 – 50 psi)
If pressure is high, replace the fuel pressure regulator.
If pressure is low, check these parts:
Fuel hoses and connections
Fuel pump
Fuel filter
Fuel pressure regulator
(k) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
(l)
Start the engine.
(m) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure:
301 – 347 kPa (3.1 – 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 – 50 psi)
(n) Stop the engine.
(o) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5
minutes after the engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure:
147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified, check the fuel pump, pressure
regulator and/or injectors.
Author:
Date:
1506
SF–8
SFI (1MZ–FE)
(p)
–
FUEL PUMP
After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the negative (–)
terminal cable from the battery and carefully remove the
SST and fuel tube connector to prevent gasoline from
splashing.
SST 09268–41047, 09268–41250, 09268–45012
(q) Reconnect the No.1 fuel pipe (fuel tube connector).
CAUTION:
Perform connecting operations of the fuel tube connector
(quick type) after observing the precautions.
(See page SF–1)
S05351
(r)
Fuel Hose
Clamp
S06086
Ohmmeter
5
4
Surely install the fuel hose clamp to the fuel filter with
”click” sound.
(s) After installing the clamp, check that the clamp is fixed by
pulling up the clamp.
(t)
Reconnect the negative (–) terminal cable to the battery.
(u) Check for fuel leaks.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
4.
REMOVE FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
5.
DISCONNECT FUEL PUMP & SENDER GAUGE
CONNECTOR
6.
INSPECT FUEL PUMP RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals
4 and 5.
Resistance: 0.2 – 3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the fuel pump.
S04508
5
Battery
4
S04509
7.
INSPECT FUEL PUMP OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 4 of
the connector, and the negative (–) lead to terminal 5. Check
that the fuel pump operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be done quickly (within 10 seconds)
to prevent the coil burning out.
Keep the fuel pump as far away from the battery as
possible.
Always do the switching at the battery side.
Author:
Date:
1507
SF–9
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
If operation is not as specified, replace the fuel pump or lead
wire.
8.
RECONNECT FUEL PUMP & SENDER GAUGE
CONNECTOR
9.
REINSTALL FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
10. REINSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION
Author:
Date:
1508
SF–10
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF07A–02
COMPONENTS
Type A
Rear Seat Cushion
Floor Service Hole Cover
x8
Fuel Pump and Sender
Gauge Connector
4 (40, 35 in.·lbf)
No.1 Fuel Tank Protector
Fuel Tank Vent Tube Set Plate
Fuel Hose
Fuel Pump Connector
Fuel Pump Assembly
Fuel Pump
Gasket
Fuel Pump Filter
Clip
Rubber Cushion
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06401
Author:
Date:
1509
SF–11
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
Type B
Rear Seat Cushion
Floor Service Hole Cover
Fuel Pump and Sender
Gauge Connector
x8
4 (40, 35 in.·lbf)
Fuel Sender Gauge
No.1 Fuel Tank Protector
Fuel Pump Flange
Fuel Tank Vent Tube Set Plate
O–Ring
Fuel Filter
Fuel Pump Assembly
Fuel Pump
Gasket
Lead Wire
Housing
Fuel Pump Filter
Clip
Rubber Cushion
”C” Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06394
Author:
Date:
1510
SF–12
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF07B–04
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Do not smoke or work near an open flame when working on
the fuel pump.
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION
2.
REMOVE FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Take out the floor carpet.
(b) Remove the service hole cover.
HINT:
At the time of installation, plaese refer to the following items.
Check for fuel leakage.
3.
DISCONNECT FUEL PUMP & SENDER GAUGE
CONNECTOR
4.
REMOVE NO.1 FUEL TANK PROTECTOR
Remove the 2 bolts and No.1 fuel tank protector.
Torque: 4 N·m (40 kgf·cm, 35 in.·lbf)
5.
S04583
DISCONNECT FUEL TUBE (FUEL TUBE CONNECTOR)
CAUTION:
Perform disconnecting and connecting operations of
the fuel tube connector (quick type) after observing
the precautions. (See page SF–1)
As there is retained pressure in the fuel pipe line, prevent it from splashing inside the vehicle compartment.
6.
(a)
Vinyl Bag
S04592
REMOVE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY FROM FUEL TANK
Remove the 6 bolts and fuel tank vent tube set plate.
Torque: 4 N·m (40 kgf·cm, 35 in.·lbf)
(b) Pull out the fuel pump assembly.
(c) Remove the gasket from the pump assembly.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fuel pump filter.
Be careful that the arm of the sender gauge should
not bent.
HINT:
At the time of installation, plaese refer to the following items.
Install a new gasket to the pump assembly.
Author:
Date:
1511
SF–13
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF07C–03
DISASSEMBLY
Type B
1.
2.
3.
DISCONNECT FUEL PUMP CONNECTOR
TYPE B:
DISCONNECT GROUND PLATE
TYPE B:
DISCONNECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE CONNECTOR
S06028
4.
Type A
(a)
(b)
(c)
Pull
Type A:
REMOVE FUEL PUMP FROM FUEL PUMP BRACKET
Pull off the lower side of the fuel pump from the pump
bracket.
Disconnect the fuel hose from the fuel pump, and remove
the fuel pump.
Remove the rubber cushion from the fuel pump.
S04603
5.
Type B:
REMOVE FUEL SENDER GAUGE
Push down the portion of A with a finger, and push up the sender gauge.
NOTICE:
Be careful that the arm of the sender gauge should not
bent.
Type B
A
Push
S06033
6.
Type B
Type B:
REMOVE FUEL FILTER
Remove the screw, and pull out the fuel filter.
Remove the O–ring from the fuel filter.
(a)
(b)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install the pump filter with a new clip.
S06050
7.
TYPE B:
REMOVE FUEL PUMP FLANGE
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap fit portion in the order of
1, 2 and 3 as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items. Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring, and install it to the
fuel filter.
Type B
(2)
(3)
(1)
S06030
Author:
Date:
1512
SF–14
SFI (1MZ–FE)
8.
Type B
–
FUEL PUMP
Type B:
REMOVE FUEL PUMP LEAD WIRE
S06027
9.
Type B
(3)
(1)
(2)
Type B:
REMOVE ”C” BRACKET, RUBBER CUSHION AND
FUEL PUMP
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap fit portion in the order of
1, 2 and 3 as shown in the illustration.
S06029
10. REMOVE FUEL PUMP FILTER FROM FUEL PUMP
(a) Using a small screwdriver, remove the clip.
(b) Pull out the pump filter.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install the pump filter with a new clip.
FI6376
Author:
Date:
1513
SF–15
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF07D–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly. (See page SF–13)
Author:
Date:
1514
SF–16
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PUMP
SF07E–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page SF–12)
Author:
Date:
1515
SF–17
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
SF07F–03
COMPONENTS
Type A
Rear Seat Cushion
Floor Service Hole Cover
x8
Fuel Pump and Sender
Gauge Connector
4 (40,35 in.·lbf)
No.1 Fuel Tank Protector
Fuel Tank Vent Tube Set Plate
Fuel Pump Assembly
Gasket
O–Ring
Fuel Pressure
Regulator
O–Ring
Fuel Filter
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06392
Author:
Date:
1516
SF–18
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
Type B
Rear Seat Cushion
Floor Service Hole Cover
x8
Fuel Pump and Sender
Gauge Connector
4 (40, 35 in.·lbf)
No.1 Fuel Tank Protector
Fuel Tank Vent Tube Set Plate
Fuel Pump Assembly
Gasket
Fuel Pressure
Regulator
O–Ring
O–Ring
Fuel Filter
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06393
Author:
Date:
1517
SF–19
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
SF07G–03
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY FROM FUEL TANK
(See page SF–12)
2.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL FILTER
Remove the screw, and pull out the fuel filter.
Torque: 2.0 N·m (20 kgf·cm, 17 in.·lbf)
Remove the O–ring from the fuel filter.
(b)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring, and install it to
the fuel filter.
S04591
3.
(a)
REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
Remove the screw, and pull out the pressure regulator.
Torque: 2.0 N·m (20 kgf·cm, 17 in.·lbf)
Remove the O–ring from the pressure regulator.
(b)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O–ring, and install it to
the pressure regulator.
S04590
Author:
Date:
1518
SF–20
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
SF07H–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page SF–19)
Author:
Date:
1519
SF–21
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
INJECTOR
INJECTOR
SF07I–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
5 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
1.
(a)
(b)
Clip
REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts.
Disconnect the 2 clips, and remove the V–bank cover.
S04528
California A/T
2.
INSPECT INJECTOR OPERATION
Check operation sound from each injector.
(1) With the engine running or cranking, use a sound
scope to check that there is normal operating noise
in proportion to engine speed.
(2) If you have no sound scope, you can check the injector operating vibration with your finger.
If no sound or unusual sound is heard, check the wiring connector, injector or injection signal from the ECM.
Sound Scope
Except California A/T
Sound Scope
B00623
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT INJECTOR RESISTANCE
Disconnect the injector connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the
terminals.
Resistance: 13.4 – 14.2 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the injector.
(c) Reconnect the injector connector.
4.
REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
HINT:
For fixing the V–bank cover, push on the cover until a ”click” is
felt.
California A/T
Ohmmeter
Except California A/T
Ohmmeter
B00624
Author:
Date:
1520
SF–22
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
INJECTOR
SF07J–03
COMPONENTS
Air Intake Chamber Stay
19.5 (200, 14)
12 (120, 9)
39 (400, 29)
PS Pressure Tube
Gasket
No.2 EGR
Pipe
Throttle Position
Sensor Connector
Gasket
EGR Valve Position
Brake Booster
Sensor Connector
No.1 Engine Hanger
43 (440, 32)
VSV Connector
for EGR
Engine Wire
V–Bank Cover
Accelerator Cable
Vacuum Hose
IAC Valve
Connector
Throttle Cable
VSV Connector for
EVAP
Ground Cable
Air Cleaner Hose
Ground Strap
Purge Hose
DLC1
PCV Hose
Air Intake Chamber
Assembly
Gasket
EGR Gas Temperature
Sensor Connector
Vacuum
Hose
Water Bypass Hose
VSV Connector for ACIS
Air Assist Hose and Pipe
19.5 (200, 14)
10 (100, 7)
Retainer
Spacer
Injector Connector
O–Ring
California A/T
Injector
Grommet
Injector
Insulator
O–Ring
High–Tension Cord Set
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06391
Author:
Date:
1521
SF–23
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
INJECTOR
SF07K–04
REMOVAL
1.
2.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
REMOVE AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(See page EM–32)
3.
DISCONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE AIR ASSIST HOSES AND PIPE
Disconnect the air assist pipe from the bracket on the
No.1 fuel pipe.
Remove the air assist hoses from the intake manifold.
5.
(a)
DISCONNECT NO.1 FUEL PIPE
Remove the fuel hose clamp.
S04505
S04498
Fuel Hose
Clamp
S06086
(b)
S05352
Disconnect the No.1 fuel pipe (fuel tube connector) from
the fuel filter outlet.
CAUTION:
Perform disconnecting operations of the fuel tube
connector (quick type) after observing the precautions. (See page SF–1)
As there is retained pressure in the fuel pipe line, prevent it from splashing inside the engine compartment.
Author:
Date:
1522
SF–24
SFI (1MZ–FE)
B01020
–
INJECTOR
6.
REMOVE DELIVERY PIPES AND INJECTORS
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the injectors when removing
the delivery pipes.
Pay attention to put any hung load on the injector to
and from the side direction.
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and delivery pipes together with the
6 injectors and No.1 fuel pipe.
(b) Remove the 4 spacers from the intake manifold.
(c) Pull out the 6 injectors from the delivery pipes.
(d) Remove the 2 O–rings and 2 grommets from each injector.
Author:
Date:
1523
SF–25
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
INJECTOR
SF07L–04
INSPECTION
California A/T
Fuel Tube Connector
SST
(Hose)
SST
(Union)
SST
(Clamp)
Injector
1.
INSPECT INJECTOR INJECTION
CAUTION:
Keep injector clear of sparks during the test.
Fuel Filter
(On Vehicle)
Except California A/T
Fuel Tube Connector
SST
(Hose)
SST
(Union)
SST
(Clamp)
Injector
Fuel Filter
(On Vehicle)
B01919
(a)
Fuel Tube Connector
Purchase the new No.1 fuel pipe and take out the fuel
tube connector from its pipe.
Part No. 23801–20041
S05359
(b)
Fuel Tube Connector
SST
(Hose)
Fuel Filter
S05357
Connect SST (hose ) and fuel tube connector to the fuel
filter outlet.
SST 09268–41047
CAUTION:
Preform connecting operations of the fuel tube connector
(quick type) after observing the precautions.
(See page SF–1)
HINT:
Use the vehicle fuel filter.
Author:
Date:
1524
SF–26
SFI (1MZ–FE)
California A/T
SST (Hose)
(c)
(d)
SST (Union)
O–Ring
SST
(Clamp)
–
INJECTOR
Install the grommet and O–Ring to the injector.
Connect SST (union and hose) to the injector, and hold
the injector and union with SST (clamp).
SST 09268–41047
Put the injector into a graduated cylinder.
(e)
HINT:
Install a suitable vinyl hose onto the injector to prevent gasoline
from splashing out.
Vinyl Tube
Except California A/T
SST (Hose)
SST (Union)
O–Ring
SST
(Clamp)
Vinyl Tube
B01914
TOYOTA
Hand–Held Tester
S05358
(f)
(g)
Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
Turn the ignition switch ON and push the TOYOTA hand–
held tester main switch ON.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(h) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA hand–
held tester.
(i)
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester operator’s
manual for further details.
(j)
If you have no TOYOTA hand–held tester, connect the
positive (+) and negative (–) leads from the battery to the
fuel pump connector. (See page SF–6)
Author:
Date:
1525
SF–27
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
INJECTOR
(k)
Connect SST (wire) to the injector and battery for 15 seconds, and measure the injection volume with a graduated cylinder. Test each injector 2 or 3 times.
SST 09842–30070
Volume:
60 – 73 cm3 (3.4 – 4.5 cu in.) per 15 sec.
Difference between each injector:
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
If the injection volume is not as specified, replace the injector.
California A/T
SST
(Wire)
Battery
Except California A/T
SST
(Wire)
Battery
California A/T
B01913
2.
(a)
Except
California A/T
B00628
INSPECT LEAKAGE
In the condition above, disconnect the test probes of SST
(wire) from the battery and check the fuel leakage from
the injector.
SST 09842–30070
Fuel drop: 1 drop or less per 12 minutes
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(c) Disconnect the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(d) Remove the SST and fuel tube connector.
SST 09268–41047, 09842–30070
CAUTION:
Perform disconnecting operations of the fuel tube
connector (quick type) after observing the precautions. (See page SF–1)
As there is retained pressure in the fuel pipe line, prevent it from splashing inside the engine compartment.
(e) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
Author:
Date:
1526
SF–28
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
INJECTOR
SF07M–04
California A/T
INSTALLATION
New Insulator
New
O–Ring
New
O–Ring
1.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL INJECTORS AND DELIVERY PIPES
Install new insulator and grommet to each injector.
Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to 2 new O–
rings and install them to each injector.
(c)
(e)
Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline on the place
where a delivery pipe touches an O–ring of the injector.
While turning the injector clockwise and counterclockwise, push it to the delivery pipes. Install the 6 injectors.
Position the injector connector outward.
(f)
Place the 4 spacers in position on the intake manifold.
New Grommet
Except California A/T
New Insulator
New
O–Ring
New
O–Ring
New Grommet
B00629
California A/T
(d)
Turn
Push
Connector
Except California A/T
Turn
Push
Connector
B00625
Spacer
Spacer
S04510
Author:
Date:
1527
SF–29
SFI (1MZ–FE)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
–
INJECTOR
Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline on the place
where a intake manifold touches an O–ring of the injector.
Place the delivery pipes and fuel pipe together with the 6
injectors in position on the intake manifold.
Temporarily install the 4 bolts holding the delivery pipes
to the intake manifold.
Temporarily install the bolt holding the No.1 fuel pipe to
the intake manifold.
B01021
(k) Check that the injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT:
If injectors do not rotate smoothly, the probable cause is incorrect installation of O–rings. Replace the O–rings.
(l)
Position the injector connector outward.
Rotate
Outward
S04728
(m)
(n)
Tighten the 4 bolts holding the delivery pipes to the intake
manifold.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Tighten the bolt holding the No.1 fuel pipe to the intake
manifold.
Torque: 19.5 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
B01020
2.
(a)
CONNECT NO.1 FUEL PIPE
Align the alignment marks (white paint) on the No.1 fuel
pipe.
Align
S06525
(b)
Connect the No.1 fuel pipe (fuel tube connector) to the
fuel filter.
CAUTION:
Perform connecting operations of the fuel tube connector
(quick type) after observing the precaution.
(See page SF–1)
S05351
Author:
Date:
1528
SF–30
SFI (1MZ–FE)
(c)
Fuel Hose
Clamp
(d)
–
INJECTOR
Surely install the fuel hose clamp to the fuel filter with
”click” sound.
After installing the clamp, check that the clamp is fixed by
pulling up the clamp.
S06086
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
5.
S04498
6.
7.
INSTALL AIR ASSIST HOSES AND PIPE
Connect the air assist hoses to the intake manifold.
Install the air assist pipe to the bracket on the No.1 fuel
pipe.
CONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
INSTALL AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(See page EM–57)
INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS
Author:
Date:
1529
SF–31
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL TANK AND LINE
FUEL TANK AND LINE
SF07N–03
COMPONENTS
CAUTION:
Always use new gaskets when replacing the fuel tank or component parts.
Apply the proper torque to all parts tightened.
x8
No.1 Fuel Tank
Protector
Fuel Tank Vent
Tube Set Plate
Fuel Pump
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Location of Fuel Tank Cushion HINT:
Before installing the heated oxygen sensor,
twist the sensor wire counterclockwise
3 and 1/2 turns.
After installing the heated oxygen sensor,
check that the sensor wire is not twisted,
if it is twisted, remove the heated oxygen
sensor and reinstall it.
Charcoal
Canister
Fuel Inlet Pipe Shield
Fuel Tank Cap
Vent Line Hose
Gasket
Fuel Outlet Tube
Gasket
EVAP Line Hose
Fuel Inlet Hose
Fuel Inlet Pipe
Fuel Inlet Pipe Protector
Fuel Tank
39 (400, 29)
Gasket
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
Fuel Tank Band
Heat Insulator
44 (450, 33)
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Center Exhaust Pipe
56 (570, 41)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06469
Author:
Date:
1530
SF–32
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL TANK AND LINE
SF07O–03
INSPECTION
Crack
Leakage
Deformation
BO0919
SST
Use SST
28 N·m
(285 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
INSPECT FUEL TANK AND LINE
(a) Check the fuel lines for cracks or leakage, and all connections for deformation.
(b) Check the fuel tank vapor vent system hoses and connections for looseness, sharp bends or damage.
(c) Check the fuel tank for deformation, cracks, fuel leakage
or tank band looseness.
(d) Check the filler neck for damage or fuel leakage.
(e) Hose and pipe connections are as shown in the illustration.
If a problem is found, repair or replace the parts as necessary.
Fulcrum
Length
30 cm
(11.81 in.)
SST: 09631–22020
Z10162
2 – 7 mm (0.08 – 0.28 in.)
Hose
Pipe
Clip
0 – 3 mm (0 – 0.12 in.)
FU0041
Author:
Date:
1531
SF–33
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER
SF07P–04
COMPONENTS
MAF Meter Connector
MAF Meter
Gasket
Non–reusable part
S04539
Author:
Date:
1532
SF–34
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER
SF07Q–03
REMOVAL
REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, MAF meter and gasket.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install a new gasket to the MAF meter.
S04755
Author:
Date:
1533
SF–35
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER
SF07R–03
Ohmmeter
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals
THA and E2.
Resistance:
THA
E2
S04526
Terminals
Resistance
Temperature
THA – E2
14.6 – 17.8 kΩ
–20°C (–4°F)
THA – E2
2.21 – 2.69 kΩ
20°C (68°F)
THA – E2
0.29 – 0.35 kΩ
60°C (140°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
E2G
VG
Air
Voltmeter
S04756
INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
Connect the MAF meter connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to
terminal VG, and negative (–) tester probe to terminal
E2G.
(d) Blow air into the MAF meter, and check that the voltage
fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
(e) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(f)
Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Author:
Date:
1534
SF–36
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER
SF07S–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page SF–34)
Author:
Date:
1535
SF–37
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
THROTTLE BODY
SF07T–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT THROTTLE BODY
Check that the throttle linkage moves smoothly.
S04593
Vacuum
Ohmmeter
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
VTA
E2
VC
S04536
(e)
(f)
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the sensor connector.
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle body.
Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between
each terminal.
Resistance:
Throttle valve
condition
Between
terminals
Resistance
Fully closed
VTA – E2
0.2 – 6.3 kΩ
Fully open
VTA – E2
2.0 – 10.2 kΩ
–
VC – E2
2.5 – 5.9 kΩ
Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle body.
Reconnect the sensor connector.
INSPECT THROTTLE OPENER
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
Check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
(c)
Plug
Disconnect
S04604
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle opener,
and plug the hose end.
(d) Check the throttle opener setting speed.
Throttle opener setting speed: 900 – 1,950 rpm
If the throttle opener setting is not as specified, replace the
throttle body.
(e) Stop the engine.
(f)
Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle opener.
(g) Start the engine and check that the idle speed returns to
the correct speed.
Author:
Date:
1536
SF–38
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
SF07U–03
COMPONENTS
Gasket
19.5 (200, 14)
Throttle Body
Throttle Position
Sensor Connector
EGR Gas Temperature
Sensor Bracket
IAC Valve Connector
Water Bypass Hose
Air Assist Hose
Accelerator Cable
Throttle Cable (A/T)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Water Bypass Hose
Air Cleaner Hose
Author:
S04741
Date:
1537
SF–39
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
SF07V–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
(a)
(b)
S04506
(a)
(e)
(c)
(b)
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(d)
(e)
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
A/T:
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
Disconnect the PCV hose.
Loosen the 2 hose clamps, and remove the air cleaner
hose.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
Disconnect the water bypass hose (from the intake manifold).
Disconnect the water bypass hose (from the water inlet
housing).
Disconnect the air assist hose.
S06123
(f)
EGR Gas Temperature
Sensor Bracket
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, EGR gas temperature sensor
bracket, throttle body and gasket.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Place a new gasket on the air intake chamber.
Torque: 19.5 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
S04527
Author:
Date:
1538
SF–40
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
SF07W–03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
S04582
Throttle
Stop Screw
CLEAN THROTTLE BODY
Using a soft brush and carburetor cleaner, clean the cast
parts.
(b) Using compressed air, clean all the passages and apertures.
NOTICE:
To prevent deterioration, do not clean the throttle position
sensor and IAC valve.
2.
(a)
(b)
Vacuum
3.
No Clearance
Throttle Lever
INSPECT THROTTLE VALVE
Apply vacuum to the throttle opener.
Check that there is no clearance between the throttle stop
screw and throttle lever when the throttle valve is fully
closed.
INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
(See page SF–37)
S04595
Author:
Date:
1539
SF–41
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
THROTTLE BODY
SF07X–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page SF–39)
Author:
Date:
1540
SF–42
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF07Y–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
E1
INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
Initial conditions:
Engine at normal operating temperature
Idle speed checked correctly
Transmission in neutral position
A/C switch OFF
(b)
DLC1
SST
TE1
DLC1
S04529
RSC
+B
RSO
Ohmmeter
S04533
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the
DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(c) After engine speed is kept at approx. 1,000 rpm for 5 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed.
If the engine speed operation is not as specified, check the IAC
valve, wiring and ECM.
(d) Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2.
INSPECT IAC VALVE RESISTANCE
NOTICE:
”Cold” and ”Hot” in the following sentences express the
temperature of the coils themselves. ”Cold” is from –10°C
(14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and ”Hot” is from 50°C (122°F) to
100°C (212°F).
(a) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminal +B and other terminals (RSC, RSO).
Resistance:
Cold
17.0 – 25.0 Ω
Hot
21.5 – 29.5 Ω
If resistance is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
(c) Reconnect the IAC valve connector.
3.
INSPECT AIR ASSIST SYSTEM
(a) Initial conditions:
Engine at normal operating temperature
Idle speed checked correctly
Transmission in neutral position
A/C switch OFF
Author:
Date:
1541
SF–43
SFI (1MZ–FE)
E1
(b)
DLC1
SST
(c)
(d)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
After engine speed is kept at 900 – 1,300 rpm for 10 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed.
Stop the engine.
TE1
DLC1
S04529
Plug
Disconnect
Plug
S04531
(e)
Disconnect the air assist hose from the air pipe, and block
off the IAC valve exit and the entry to the pipe.
(f)
Start the engine and check that the idle speed reaches
500 rpm or below (the engine may stall).
If the idle does not reach 500 rpm or below, check for a leak between the air assist hoses, pipe and injectors.
(g) Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(h) Reconnect the air assist hose to the air pipe.
Author:
Date:
1542
SF–44
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF07Z–03
COMPONENTS
Gasket
19.5 (200, 14)
Throttle Body
Throttle Position
Sensor Connector
Throttle Body
EGR Gas Temperature
Sensor Bracket
IAC Valve Connector
Gasket
IAC Valve
Water Bypass Hose
Air Assist Hose
Water Bypass Hose
Accelerator Cable)
Throttle Cable (A/T)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Air Cleaner Hose
Author:
S04742
Date:
1543
SF–45
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF080–03
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY (See page SF–39)
2.
REMOVE IAC VALVE
Remove the 4 screws, IAC valve and gasket.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Place a new gasket on the throttle body.
P14340
Author:
Date:
1544
SF–46
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF081–03
INSPECTION
RSC
+B
INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
+B and negative (–) lead to terminal RSC, and check that
the valve is closed.
Battery
Closed
P14290
(b)
+B
RSC
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
+B and negative (–) lead to terminal RSO, and check that
the valve is open.
If operation is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
Battery
Open
P14289
Author:
Date:
1545
SF–47
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
SF082–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page SF–45)
Author:
Date:
1546
SF–48
SFI (1MZ–FE)
Vacuum Gage
–
ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION SYSTEM (ACIS)
ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION
SYSTEM (ACIS)
SF083–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
S05036
Approx.
27.6 kPa
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
(a) Using a 3–way connector, connect vacuum gauge to the
actuator hose.
(b) Start the engine.
(c) While the engine is idling, check that the vacuum gauge
needle does not move.
(d)
Rapidly depress the accelerator pedal to fully open position and check that the vacuum gauge needle momentarily fluctuates up to approx. 26.7 kPa (200 mmHg, 7.9
in.Hg). (The actuator rod is pulled out.)
S05037
Author:
Date:
1547
SF–49
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION SYSTEM (ACIS)
SF084–03
COMPONENTS
Gasket
Intake Air Control Valve
14.5 (145, 10)
DLC1 Bracket
DLC1
Actuator Vacuum Hose
Ground Strap
Ground Cable
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06467
Author:
Date:
1548
SF–50
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION SYSTEM (ACIS)
SF085–02
REMOVAL
(2)
1.
2.
DISCONNECT ACTUATOR VACUUM HOSE
DISCONNECT DLC1 FROM DLC1 BRACKET
3.
(a)
REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
Remove the 4 nuts and DLC1 bracket, and disconnect the
ground strap and cable.
Remove the intake air control valve by prying a screwdriver between the intake air control valve and air intake
chamber.
Remove the gasket.
(1)
B06470
(b)
(c)
B06471
Author:
Date:
1549
SF–51
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION SYSTEM (ACIS)
SF086–03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
With 26.7 kPa (200 mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg) of vacuum applied
to the actuator, check that the actuator rod moves.
(b) One minute after applying the vacuum in (a), check that
the actuator rod does not return.
If the operation is not as specified, replace the intake air control
valve.
Vacuum
S05041
Air
2.
INSPECT VACUUM TANK
LOCATION: The LH side member under the battery tray.
(a) Check that air flows from port B to port A.
(b) Check that air does not flow from port A to port B.
Air
S05689
Vacuum
(c)
Plug port B with your finger, and apply 26.7 kPa (200
mmHg, 7.9 in.Hg) of vacuum to port A, and check that
there is no change is vacuum after one minute.
If the operation is not as specified, replace the vacuum tank.
3.
INSPECT VSV (See page SF–60)
S05688
Author:
Date:
1550
SF–52
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION SYSTEM (ACIS)
SF087–03
INSTALLATION
New Gasket
1.
(a)
INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONTROL VALVE
Install a new gasket to the air intake chamber.
(b)
(c)
Apply a light coat of engine oil to the rubber portions.
Apply seal packing to the positions of the intake air control
valve shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Install the intake air control valve, DLC1 bracket, ground
strap and cable with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 14.5 N·m (145 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
CONNECT DLC1
CONNECT ACTUATOR VACUUM HOSE
B06468
Seal
Packing
Seal
Packing
(d)
Rubber
S05052
2.
3.
Author:
Date:
1551
SF–53
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
EFI MAIN RELAY
EFI MAIN RELAY
SF088–03
INSPECTION
1.
2.
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI)
EFI Main
Relay
S05392
Continuity
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
2
1
5
3
3.
(a)
INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY CONTINUITY
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 3 and
5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
No Continuity
S04970
2
Ohmmeter
1
5
3
4.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY OPERATION
Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
5.
REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
6.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
Battery
Continuity
S04969
Author:
Date:
1552
SF–54
SFI (1MZ–FE)
Circuit Opening
Relay
–
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
SF089–03
INSPECTION
1.
2.
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
REMOVE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
(Marking: CIR OPN)
S05389
3.
(a)
Continuity
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
2
1
5
3
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY CONTINUITY
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 3 and
5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
No Continuity
S04970
2
Ohmmeter
1
5
3
4.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY OPERATION
Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
5.
REINSTALL CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
6.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
Battery
Continuity
S04969
Author:
Date:
1553
SF–55
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR)
VSV FOR EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR)
SF08A–03
COMPONENTS
Vacuum Hose
V–Bank Cover
VSV for EGR
Emission Control Valve Set
High–Tension Cord Cover
VSV Connector for EVAP
VSV Connector for EGR
VSV Connector for ACIS
S04762
Author:
Date:
1554
SF–56
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR)
SF08B–03
INSPECTION
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
REMOVE V–BANK COVER, HIGH–TENSION CORD
COVER AND EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
REMOVE VSV
Disconnect the 3 vacuum hoses from the VSV.
Remove the screw and VSV.
3.
INSPECT VSV FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the
terminals.
Resistance: 27 – 33 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
Continuity
S04514
4.
INSPECT VSV FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between
each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
S04513
5.
(a)
Air
INSPECT VSV OPERATION
Check that air flows from port E to port G.
E
G
S04515
Air
Battery
S04512
(b) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
6.
REINSTALL VSV
(a) Install the VSV with the screw.
(b) Connect the 3 vacuum hoses to the VSV.
7.
REINSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
8.
REINSTALL HIGH–TENSION CORD COVER
9.
REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Author:
Date:
1555
SF–57
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
VSV FOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
SF08C–03
COMPONENTS
V–Bank Cover
EVAP Hose
VSV for EVAP
Emission Control Valve Set
High–Tension Cord Cover
VSV Connector for EVAP
VSV for ACIS
VSV Connector for ACIS
VSV Connector for EGR
S04761
Author:
Date:
1556
SF–58
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
SF08D–03
INSPECTION
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
REMOVE V–BANK COVER, HIGH–TENSION CORD
COVER AND EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
REMOVE VSV
Disconnect the 2 EVAP hoses from the VSV.
Remove the screw and VSV.
3.
INSPECT VSV FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the
terminals.
Resistance: 27 – 33 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
Continuity
S04522
Ohmmeter
4.
INSPECT VSV FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between
each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
No Continuity
S04521
5.
(a)
Air
F
INSPECT VSV OPERATION
Check that air flows with difficulty from port E to port F.
E
P18857
Air
E
F
Battery
S04520
(b) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
6.
REINSTALL VSV
(a) Install the VSV with the screw.
(b) Connect the 2 EVAP hoses to the VSV.
7.
REINSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
8.
REINSTALL HIGH–TENSION CORD COVER
9.
REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Author:
Date:
1557
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION
SYSTEM (ACIS)
SF–59
VSV FOR ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION SYSTEM (ACIS)
SF08E–03
COMPONENTS
Emission Control Valve Set
High–Tension Cord Cover
VSV Connector for EVAP
VSV Connector for EGR
VSV Connector for ACIS
Vacuum Hose
VSV for ACIS
S04760
Author:
Date:
1558
SF–60
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR ACOUSTIC CONTROL INDUCTION
SYSTEM (ACIS)
SF08F–04
INSPECTION
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
REMOVE V–BANK COVER, HIGH–TENSION CORD
COVER AND EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
REMOVE VSV
Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the VSV.
Remove the screw and VSV.
3.
INSPECT VSV FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between
each terminals.
Resistance: 33 – 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
Continuity
S04525
Ohmmeter
4.
INSPECT VSV FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between
each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
No Continuity
S04524
5.
(a)
Air
INSPECT VSV OPERATION
Check that air flows from port E to the filter.
E
Filter
FI6393
Air
E
F
Battery
S04523
(b) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to port F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
6.
REINSTALL VSV
(a) Install the VSV with the screw.
(b) Connect the 2 vacuum to the VSV.
7.
REINSTALL EMISSION CONTROL VALVE SET
8.
REINSTALL HIGH–TENSION CORD COVER
9.
REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
Author:
Date:
1559
SF–61
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF08G–03
COMPONENTS
VSV for Vapor Pressure
Sensor Connector
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Hose
Charcoal Canister
B06550
Author:
Date:
1560
SF–62
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF08H–03
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE VSV
2.
INSPECT VSV FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the
terminals.
Resistance: 33 – 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
B01273
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
3.
INSPECT VSV FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between
each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
B00798
4.
(a)
Air
INSPECT VSV OPERATION
Check that air flows from ports E to G.
E
G
B00799
(b) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from ports E to F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
5.
REINSTALL VSV
Air
E
F
Battery
B00800
Author:
Date:
1561
SF–63
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
SF08I–03
INSPECTION
19 mm
Deep Socket
Wrench
ECT Switch
Gasket
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ECT SENSOR
Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench, remove the ECT
sensor and gasket.
S04759
Ohmmeter
30
20
10
Resistance kΩ
1.
5
3
2
Acceptable
3.
INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
4.
REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
5.
REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
–20
0
20 40 60 80 100
(–4) (32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
S01196
S01699
Temperature °C (°F)
Z17274
Author:
Date:
1562
SF–64
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF0Z9–01
COMPONENTS
Vapor Pressure Sensor
(Type B)
Vapor Pressure Sensor
(Type A)
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Connector
Vacuum hose
Charcoal Canister
B06554
Author:
Date:
1563
SF–62
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF08H–03
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE VSV
2.
INSPECT VSV FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the
terminals.
Resistance: 33 – 39 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
B01273
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
3.
INSPECT VSV FOR GROUND
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between
each terminal and the body.
If there is continuity, replace the VSV.
B00798
4.
(a)
Air
INSPECT VSV OPERATION
Check that air flows from ports E to G.
E
G
B00799
(b) Apply battery positive voltage across the terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from ports E to F.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
5.
REINSTALL VSV
Air
E
F
Battery
B00800
Author:
Date:
1561
SF–63
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
SF08I–03
INSPECTION
19 mm
Deep Socket
Wrench
ECT Switch
Gasket
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ECT SENSOR
Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench, remove the ECT
sensor and gasket.
S04759
Ohmmeter
30
20
10
Resistance kΩ
1.
5
3
2
Acceptable
3.
INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
4.
REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
5.
REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
0.1
–20
0
20 40 60 80 100
(–4) (32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
S01196
S01699
Temperature °C (°F)
Z17274
Author:
Date:
1562
SF–64
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF0Z9–01
COMPONENTS
Vapor Pressure Sensor
(Type B)
Vapor Pressure Sensor
(Type A)
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Connector
Vacuum hose
Charcoal Canister
B06554
Author:
Date:
1563
SF–65
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
SF08J–04
Voltmeter
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Disconnect
VC
E2
B00801
(d)
(e)
2.
Type A
(a)
(b)
(c)
Air
Vacuum
Disconnect
Type B
Disconnect
Air
Vacuum
(d)
(e)
INSPECT POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE OF VAPOR
PRESSURE SENSOR
Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between connector terminals VC and E2 of the wiring harness side.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Reconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
INSPECT POWER OUTPUT OF VAPOR PRESSURE
SENSOR
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure
sensor.
Connect a voltmeter to terminals PTNK and E2 of the
ECM, and measure the output voltage under the following
conditions:
(1) Apply vacuum (2.0 kPa (15 mmHg, 0.59 in.Hg)) to
the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 1.3 – 2.1 V
(2) Release the vacuum from the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 3.0 – 3.6 V
(3) Apply pressure (1.5 kPa (15 gf/cm2, 0.22 psi)) to the
vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 4.2 – 4.8 V
Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Reconnect the vacuum hose to the vapor pressure sensor.
ECM
PTNK
E2
B06389
Author:
Date:
1564
SF–66
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
KNOCK SENSOR
KNOCK SENSOR
SF08K–03
COMPONENTS
Air Intake Chamber Stay
19.5 (200, 14)
V–Bank Cover
12 (120, 19)
39 (400, 19)
PS Pressure Tube
Gasket
No.2 EGR Pipe
Throttle Position
Sensor Connector
No.1 Engine
Hanger
43 (440, 32)
VSV Connector
for EGR
Engine Wire
Brake Booster EGR Valve Position
Vacuum Hose Sensor Connector Accelerator Cable
Gasket
IAC Valve
Connector
VSV Connector for
EVAP
Ground Cable
Throttle Cable
Air Cleaner
Hose
Ground Starp
DLC1
PCV Hose
Air Intake Chamber
Assembly
Gasket
VSV Connector for ACIS
Engine Coolant
15 (150, 11)
ECT Sender
Reservoir Hose
Gauge Connector
Upper Radiator
x9
Hose
ECT Sensor
Engine
Connector
Wire
Band
Grand Strap
Connector
Purge Hose EGR Gas Temperature
Sensor Connector
Water
Bypass Hose
Vacuum
Hose
Air Assist Hose
Water Bypass Hose
Retainer
Fuel Inlet Hose
Heater Hose
Intake Manifold Assembly
15 (150, 11)
Injector Connector
Water Outlet
Gasket
Gasket
Knock Sensor
Connector
High–Tension Cord
Set
Knock Sensor
39 (400, 29)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06390
Author:
Date:
1565
SF–67
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
KNOCK SENSOR
SF08L–03
INSPECTION
Knock Sensor 1
SST
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY AND
WATER OUTLET (Seepage EM–32)
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Disconnect the knock sensor connector.
Using SST, remove the knock sensor.
SST 09817–16011
Knock Sensor 2
P20115
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P01630
5.
INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between
the terminal and body.
If there is continuity, replace the sensor.
6.
REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
(a) Using SST, install the knock sensor.
SST 09817–16011
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the knock sensor connector.
7.
REINSTALL WATER OUTLET AND INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY (See page EM–57)
8.
REINSTALL RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
9.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE
Author:
Date:
1566
SF–68
SFI (1MZ–FE)
Bank 1 Sensor 1
+B
Ohmmeter
HT
–
AIR–FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR (California A/T)
AIR–FUEL RATIO (A/F) SENSOR
(California A/T)
SF08M–06
INSPECTION
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF A/F SENSORS
(Bank 1 sensor 1, Bank 2 Sensor 1)
(a) Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter measure the resistance between terminals +B and HT.
Resistance:
Bank 2 Sensor 1
Ohmmeter
+B
HT
At 20°C (68°F)
0.8 – 1.4 Ω
At 800°C (1,472°F)
1.8 – 3.2 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 44 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
S05042
Author:
Date:
1567
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) GAS
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
SF–69
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) GAS
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
SF08N–03
COMPONENTS
Gasket
19.5 (200, 14)
Throttle Body
Throttle Position
Sensor Connector
EGR Gas Temperature Sensor
Accelerator Cable
(A/T)
Throttle Cable
IAC Valve Connector
Water Bypass Hose
Air Assist Hose
Water Bypass Hose
EGR Gas Temperature
Sensor Bracket
EGR Gas Temperature
Sensor Connector
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Air Cleaner Hose
Author:
S04740
Date:
1568
SF–70
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) GAS
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
SF08O–04
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY (See page SF–39)
2.
REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
S04504
3.
INSPECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance:
Oil
Ohmmeter
P03193
At 50°C (122°F)
64 – 97 kΩ
At 100°C (212°F)
11 – 16 kΩ
At 150°C (302°F)
2 – 4 kΩ
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
4.
REINSTALL EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
5.
REINSTALL THROTTLE BODY (See page SF–41)
Author:
Date:
1569
SF–71
SFI (1MZ–FE)
Bank 1 Sensor 1
+B
Ohmmeter
HT
–
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank 1,2 Sensor 1)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank
1,2 Sensor 1)
SF08P–04
INSPECTION
Except California A/T:
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF HEATED OXYGEN
SENSORS (Bank 1 Sensor 1, Bank 2 Sensor 1)
(a) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the
terminals +B and HT.
Resistance:
Bank 2 Sensor 1
Ohmmeter
+B
HT
At 20°C (68°F)
11 – 16 Ω
At 800°C (1,472°F)
23 – 32 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(c) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
S05042
Author:
Date:
1570
SF–72
SFI (1MZ–FE)
Ohmmeter
+B
–
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (Bank
1 Sensor 2)
HT
SF08Q–03
INSPECTION
S05163
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
(a) Remove the driver’s seat.
(b) Take out the floor carpet.
(c) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
(d) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the
terminals +B and HT.
Resistance:
At 20°C (68°F)
11 – 16 Ω
At 800°C (1,472°F)
23 – 32 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
(e) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(f)
Reinstall the floor carpet.
(g) Reinstall the driver’s seat.
Author:
Date:
1571
SF–73
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM)
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM)
SF08R–03
COMPONENTS
ECM
ECM Connector
No.2 Instrument
Lower Panel
Under Cover
Front Door Inside Scuff Plate
Cowl Side Trim
S05450
Author:
Date:
1572
SF–74
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM)
SF08S–01
INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE ECM
INSPECT ECM (See page DI–218)
REINSTALL ECM
Author:
Date:
1573
SF–75
SFI (1MZ–FE)
–
FUEL CUT RPM
FUEL CUT RPM
SF08T–03
INSPECTION
5 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
1.
REMOVE V–BANK COVER
(a) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 cap nuts.
(b) Disconnect the 2 clips, and remove the V–bank cover.
2.
WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
Clip
S04528
TOYOTA
Hand–Held Tester
3.
(a)
(b)
CONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR OBDII
SCAN TOOL
Connect the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII scan
tool to the DLC3.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII
scan tool operator’s manual for further details.
S05358
California A/T
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Sound Scope
INSPECT FUEL CUT OFF PRM
Increase the engine speed to at least 3,500 rpm.
Use a sound scope to check for injector operating noise.
Check that when the throttle lever is released, injector operation noise stops momentarily and then resumes.
HINT:
Measure with the A/C OFF.
Fuel return rpm: 1,200 rpm
5.
DISCONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR
OBDII SCAN TOOL
6.
REINSTALL V–BANK COVER
HINT:
For fixing the V–bank cover, push on the cover until a ”click” is
felt.
Except California A/T
Sound Scope
B00623
Author:
Date:
1574
IN–1
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
IN002–0W
To assist you in finding your way through the manual, the Section Title and major heading are given
at the top of every page.
PREPARATION
Preparation lists the SST (Special Service Tools), recommended tools, equipment, lubricant and SSM
(Special Service Materials) which should be prepared before beginning the operation and explains the
purpose of each one.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
Most repair operations begin with an overview illustration. It identifies the components and shows how
the parts fit together.
Example:
IN–2
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The
procedures are presented in a step–by–step format:
The illustration shows what to do and where to do it.
The task heading tells what to do.
The detailed text tells how to perform the task and gives other information such as specifications
and warnings.
Example:
This format provides the experienced technician with a FAST TRACK to the information needed. The
upper case task heading can be read at a glance when necessary, and the text below it provides detailed information. Important specifications and warnings always stand out in bold type.
REFERENCES
References have been kept to a minimum. However, when they are required you are given the page
to refer to.
SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications are presented in bold type throughout the text where needed. You never have to leave
the procedure to look up your specifications. They are also found at the back of AX section, for quick
reference.
IN–3
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
CAUTIONS, NOTICES, HINTS:
CAUTIONS are presented in bold type, and indicate there is a possibility of injury to you or other
people.
NOTICES are also presented in bold type, and indicate the possibility of damage to the components being repaired.
HINTS are separated from the text but do not appear in bold. They provide additional information
to help you perform the repair efficiently.
SI UNIT
The UNITS given in this manual are primarily expressed according to the SI UNIT (International System
of Unit), and alternately expressed in the metric system and in the English system.
Example:
Torque: 30 N·m (310 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
IN–4
INTRODUCTION
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
IN022–07
Use fender, seat and floor covers to keep the vehicle
clean and prevent damage.
During disassembly, keep parts in the appropriate order
to facilitate reassembly.
Observe the following:
(a) Before performing electrical work, disconnect the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(b) If it is necessary to disconnect the battery for inspection or repair, always disconnect the cable from the
negative (–) terminal which is grounded to the vehicle body.
(c) To prevent damage to the battery terminal post, loosen the terminal nut and raise the cable straight up
without twisting or prying it.
(d) Clean the battery terminal posts and cable terminals
with a clean shop rag. Do not scrape them with a file
or other abrasive objects.
(e) Install the cable terminal to the battery post with the
nut loose, and tighten the nut after installation. Do
not use a hammer to tap the terminal onto the post.
(f) Be sure the cover for the positive (+) terminal is properly in place.
Check hose and wiring connectors to make sure that they
are secure and correct.
Non–reusable parts
(a) Always replace cotter pins, gaskets, O–rings and oil
seals etc. with new ones.
(b) Non–reusable parts are indicated in the component
illustrations by the ”” symbol.
Precoated parts
Precoated parts are bolts and nuts, etc. that are coated
with a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(a) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
caused to move in any way, it must be recoated with
the specified adhesive.
(b) When reusing precoated parts, clean off the old
adhesive and dry with compressed air. Then apply
IN–5
INTRODUCTION
7.
8.
9.
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
the specified seal lock adhesive to the bolt, nut or
threads.
(c) Precoated parts are indicated in the component illustrations by the ”” symbol.
When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to prevent
leaks.
Carefully observe all specifications for bolt tightening
torques. Always use a torque wrench.
Use of special service tools (SST) and special service materials (SSM) may be required, depending on the nature
of the repair. Be sure to use SST and SSM where specified and follow the proper work procedure. A list of SST
and SSM can be found at the preparation of AX section.
10. When replacing fuses, be sure the new fuse has the correct amperage rating. DO NOT exceed the rating or use
one with a lower rating.
11. To pull apart electrical connectors, pull on the connector
itself, not the wires.
12. Care must be taken when jacking up and supporting the
vehicle. Be sure to lift and support the vehicle at the proper locations.
(a) If the vehicle is to be jacked up only at the front or
rear end, be sure to block the wheels at the opposite
end in order to ensure safety.
(b) After the vehicle is jacked up, be sure to support it on
stands. It is extremely dangerous to do any work on
a vehicle raised on a jack alone, even for a small job
that can be finished quickly.
IN–6
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
IN016–02
This glossary lists all SAE–J1930 terms and abbreviations used in this manual in compliance with SAE
recommendations, as well as their Toyota equivalents.
SAE
TOYOTA TERMS
SAE TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS
( )––ABBREVIATIONS
A/C
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
AP
Accelerator Pedal
B+
Battery Positive Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
CL
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CMP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CPP
Clutch Pedal Position
–
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
–
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
–
DFI
Direct Fuel Injection (Diesel)
DI
Distributor Ignition
DLC1
Data Link Connector 1
1: Check Connector
DLC2
Data Link Connector 2
2: Toyota Diagnosis Communication Link (TDCL)
DLC3
Data Link Connector 3
3: OBD@@@@@: [g 2] Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
ECL
Engine Control Level
ECM
Engine Control Module
Engine ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory
–
+B, Battery Voltage
–
–
Direct Injection (DI)
–
–
–
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM),
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
EI
Electronic Ignition
Toyota Distributorless Ignition (TDI)
EM
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
EPROM
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
EVAP
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
FC
Fan Control
FEEPROM
–
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable
–
Read Only Memory
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
–
FF
Flexible Fuel
–
FP
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
GEN
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
HO2S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
IN–7
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
IAC
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
IFI
Indirect Fuel Injection
IFS
Inertia Fuel–Shutoff
–
ISC
Idle Speed Control
–
KS
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
–
Indirect Injection
Manifold Pressure
Intake Vacuum
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
MC
Mixture Control
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
MFI
Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Check Engine Light
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
–
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
–
NVRAM
Non–Volatile Random Access Memory
–
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, O2 Sensor (O2S)
OBD
On–Board Diagnostic
On–Board Diagnostic (OBD)
OC
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalyst Converter (OC), CCo
OP
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
–
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
–
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
–
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
–
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
RAM
Random Access Memory
RM
Relay Module
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
SC
Supercharger
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger Bypass
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
–
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
–
SRT
System Readiness Test
–
ST
Scan Tool
–
TB
Throttle Body
TBI
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TC
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
Torque Converter
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Transmission ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
TP
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TR
Transmission Range
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
–
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
Random Access Memory (RAM)
–
–
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
Throttle Body
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
–
IN–8
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
TWC
Three–Way Catalytic Converter
TWC+OC
Three–Way + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR + CCo
VAF
Volume Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
VR
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Read Switch Type)
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU–OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
WU–TWC
Warm Up Three–Way Catalytic Converter
3GR
Third Gear
–
4GR
Fourth Gear
–
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
Three–Way Catalyst (TWC)
CCRO
–
Manifold Converter
IN–9
INTRODUCTION
–
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS
MANUAL
IN01H–0R
ATF
Automatic Transaxle Fluid
B0
Overdrive Brake
B1
Second coast Brake
B2
Second Brake
B3
First and Reverse Brake
C0
Overdrive Direct Clutch
C1
Forward Clutch
C2
Direct Clutch
D
Disc
F
Flange
F0
O/D One–way Clutch
F1
No.1 One–way Clutch
F2
No.2 One–way Clutch
MP
Multipurpose
O/D
Overdirve
P
Plate
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
IN–10
INTRODUCTION
–
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
IN008–02
IN–11
INTRODUCTION
–
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
AX–12
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
AT06P–0C
SERVICE DATE
Oil Pump
Body clearance
STD
Maximum
Tip clearance
STD
Maximum
Side clearance
STD
Maximum
Pump body bushing inside diameter
Maximum
0.07 – 0.15 mm
0.0028 – 0.0059 in.
0.3 mm
0.012 in.
0.11 – 0.14 mm
0.0043 – 0.0055 in.
0.3 mm
0.012 in.
0.02 – 0.05 mm
0.0008 – 0.0020 in.
0.1 mm
0.004 in.
38.18 mm
1.5031 in.
Stator shaft bushing inside diameter
Front side
Maximum
21.57 mm
0.8492 in.
Rear side
Maximum
27.07 mm
1.0657 in.
Direct Clutch
Clutch drum bushing inside diameter
Direct clutch piston stroke
Maximum
47.07 mm
1.8531 in.
1.11 – 1.44 mm
0.0437 – 0.0567 in.
2.60 mm
Flange thickness
0.1024 in.
3.00 mm
0.1181 in.
Forward Clutch
Piston stroke
1.41 – 1.82 mm
0.0555 – 0.0717 in.
2.8 mm
0.110 in.
3.0 mm
Flange thickness
0.118 in.
3.2 mm
0.126 in.
3.4 mm
0.134 in.
3.6 mm
0.142 in.
Front Planetary Gear
AX–13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Ring gear bushing inside diameter
Standard
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
Standard
19.025 – 19.050 mm
0.7490 – 0.7500 in.
0.20 – 0.50 mm
0.0079 – 0.0197 in.
Rear Planetary Gear
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
Standard
0.20 – 0.50 mm
0.0079 – 0.0197 in.
Overdrive Unit
1.21 – 1.91 mm
Overdrive direct clutch piston stroke
Overdrive direct clutch bushing inside diameter
0.0476 – 0.0752 in.
Maximam
0.8697 in.
9 – 15 N
Counter drive gear preload
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
22.09 mm
920 – 1,530 gf
Standard
2.0 – 3.4 lbf
0.20 – 0.50 mm
0.0079 – 0.0197 in.
AX–14
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Valve Body Spring
Free length and Coil outer
Spring
diameter
Total No. of coils and Color
mm (in.)
Upper valve body
21.7 (0.854)
Throttle modulator valve
9.5 (0.374)
9.5
None
28.1 (0.105)
Accumulator control valve
10.6 (0.417)
13.0
Yellow
21.6 (0.850)
Low coast modulator valve
7.9 (0.311)
11.5
None
29.8 (1.172)
Down shift plug
8.7 (0.344)
13.5
Yellow
30.7 (1.209)
Throttle valve
9.2 (0.362)
9.5
None
20.9 (0.824)
Second coast modulator valve
8.5 (0.336)
10.0
Light Green
21.8 (0.858)
Cut–back valve
6.0 (0.236)
13.5
None
26.6 (1.046)
Lock–up relay valve
10.2 (0.402)
11.5
Green
Lower valve body
11.2 (0.441)
Pressure relief valve
6.4 (0.252)
7.5
None
29.3 (1.152)
1 – 2 shift valve
9.7 (0.382)
10.5
None
29.3 (1.152)
2 – 3 shift valve
9.7 (0.382)
10.5
None
29.3 (1.152)
3 – 4 shift valve
9.7 (0.382)
10.5
None
66.7 (2.453)
Primary regulator valve
18.6 (0.732)
12.5
None
43.6 (1.717)
Secondary regulator valve
10.9 (0.429)
11.5
None
30.0 (1.181)
Lock–up signal valve
8.2 (0.323)
11.5
None
19.9 (0.784)
Cooler By–pass valve
11.0 (0.433)
8.5
None
Valve Body Retainer
Height
Width
Thickness
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
Throttle Modulator valve
9.2 (0.362)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Accumulator control valve
11.5 (0.453)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Cut–back valve
9.2 (0.591)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Lock–up relay valve
15.0 (0.591)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Second coast modulator valve
15.0 (0.591)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
9.2 (0.362)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Reteiner
Upper valve body
Lower valve body
Primary regulator valve
AX–15
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
1 – 2 shift valve
9.2 (0.362)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
2 – 3 shift valve
8.0 (0.315)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
3 – 4 shift valve
8.0 (0.315)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Lock–up signal valve
15.0 (0.591)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Accumulator Spring
Spring
Free length mm (in.)
Color
C1
57.64 (2.2693)
Red, Purple
B2
69.39 (2.7323)
Green, White
C2
70.21 (2.7641)
Purple
AX–16
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Differential
1.0 – 1.6 N·m
Drive pinion preload (at starting)
New bearing 10 – 16 kgf·cm
Reused bearing
8.7 – 13.9 in.·lbf
0.5 – 0.8 N·m
5 – 8 kgf·cm
4.3 – 6.9 in.·lbf
Add drive pinion preload
Total preload (at starting)
0.3 – 0.4 N·m
New bearing 2.9 – 4.0 kgf·cm
1.5 – 2.0 kgf·cm
Pinion to side gear backlash
2.5 – 3.5 in.·lbf
0.1 – 0.2 N·m
Reused bearing
1.3 – 1.7 in.·lbf
0.05 – 0.20 mm
0.0020 – 0.0079 in.
0.95 mm
0.0374 in.
1.00 mm
0.0394 in.
1.05 mm
Side gear thrust washer thickness
0.0413 in.
1.10 mm
0.0433 in.
1.20 mm
0.0427 in.
AX–17
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
1.90 mm
0.0748 in.
1.95 mm
0.0768 in.
2.00 mm
0.0787 in.
2.05 mm
0.0807 in.
2.10 mm
0.0827 in.
2.15 mm
0.0846 in.
2.20 mm
0.0866 in.
2.25 mm
0.0886 in.
2.30 mm
0.0906 in.
Side bearing adjusting shim thickness
2.35 mm
0.0925 in.
2.40 mm
0.0945 in.
2.45 mm
0.0965 in.
2.50 mm
0.0984 in.
2.55 mm
0.1004 in.
2.60 mm
0.1024 in.
2.65 mm
0.1043 in.
2.70 mm
0.1063 in.
2.75 mm
0.1083 in.
2.80 mm
0.1103 in.
AX–18
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
AT06Q–0C
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Stator shaft x Oil pump body
10
100
7
Upper valve body x Lower valve body
5.4
55
48
Ring gear x Differential case
97
985
71
Side bearing cap x Transaxle case
72
730
53
Bearing retainer x Transaxle case
19
195
14
Counter drive gear x Drive pinion
172
1,750
127
Carrier cover x Transaxle case
25
250
18
Parking lock pawl bracket
7.4
75
65 in.·lbf
Overdrive case x Transaxle case
25
260
19
Oil pump x Transaxle case
22
220
16
Valve body x Transaxle case
10
100
7
Manual valve body x Transaxle case
10
100
7
Detent spring x Valve body
10
100
7
Oil tube bracket x Transaxle case
10
100
7
Oil strainer x Valve body
10
100
7
Oil pan x Transaxle case
4.9
50
43 in.·lbf
Park/Neutral position switch
6.9
70
61 in.·lbf
Park/Neutral position switch adjusting bolt
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Union
27
275
20
AX–1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
AX0EP–02
The A140E automatic transaxle described in this AX section is a 4–speed lock–up automatic transaxle
developed exclusively for use with a transversely–mounted engine.
AX–2
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
General Specifications
Type of Transaxle
A140E
Type of Engine
5S–FE
Torque Converter Clutch Stall Torque Ratio
2.0 : 1
Lock–up Mechanism
Gear Ratio
Number of Discs and Plates
Equipped
1st Gear
2.810
2nd Gear
1.549
3rd Gear
1.000
O/D Gear
0.706
Reverse Gear
2.296
O/D Direct Clutch (C0)
2/1
Forward Clutch (C1)
4/4
Direct Clutch (C2)
3/3
Second Brake (B2)
3/3
First and Reverse Brake (B3)
6/5
O/D Brake (B0)
B1 Band Width
mm (in.)
ATF DEXRON ® @@@@@: [g 2]
ATF Type
Capacity
2/3
25 mm (0.98 in.)
liter (US qts, Imp. qts)
Transaxle
5.6 (5.9, 4.9)
Differential
1.6 (1.7, 1.4)
AX–3
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
OPERATION
AX0SW–01
OPERATION
AX–4
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
1.
–
OPERATION
FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
FUNCTION
O/D Direct Clutch (C0)
O/D Brake (B0)
O/D One–way Clutch (F0)
OPERATION
Connects overdrive sun gear and overdrive carrier
Prevents overdrive sun gear from turning either clockwise or
counterclockwise
When transmission is being driven by engine, connects overdrive sun
gear and overdrive carrier.
Front Clutch (C1)
Connects input shaft and intermediate shaft
Rear Clutch (C2)
Connects input shaft and front and rear planetary sun gears
No.1 Brake (B1)
No.2 Brake (B2)
No.3 Brake (B3)
No.1 One–way Clutch (F1)
No.2 One–way Clutch (F2)
Prevents front and rear planetary sun gears from turning either clockwise
or counterclockwise
Prevents outer race of F1 from turning either clockwise or counterclockwise, thus
previnting front and rear planetary sun gears from turning counterclockwise
Prevents front planetary carrier from turning either clockwise or counterclockwise
When B2 is operating prevents front and rear planetary sun gears from turning
counterclockwise
Prevents front planetary carrier from turning counterclockwise
AX–5
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
Power from the engine transmitted to the input shaft via the torque converter is then transmitted to the
planetary gears by the operation of the clutch.
By operation of the brake and one–way clutch, either the planetary carrier or the planetary sun gear
are immobilized, altering the speed of revolution of the planetary gear unit.
Shift change is carried out by altering the combination of clutch and brake operation.
Each clutch and brake operates by hydraulic pressure; gear position is decided according to the throttle
opening angle and vehicle speed, and shift change automatically occurs.
The conditions of operation for each gear position are shown on the following illustrations:
AX–6
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
–
OPERATION
HYDRAULIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The hydraulic control system is composed of the oil pump, the valve body, the solenoid valves, the accumulators, the clutches and brakes, and the governor valve as well as the fluid passages which connect
all of these components.
Based on the hydraulic pressure created by the oil pump, the hydraulic control system governs the hydraulic pressure acting on the torque converter clutch, clutches and brakes in accordance with the vehicle driving conditions.
There are three solenoid valves on the valve body.
The No.1 and No.2 solenoid valves are turned on and off by signals from the ECM to operate the shift
valves and change the gear shift position.
The No.3 solenoid valve is operated by signals from the ECM to engage or disengage the lock–up
clutch of the torque converter.
AX–7
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
–
OPERATION
ELECTRONIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The electronic control system for controlling the shift timing and the operation of the lock–up clutch is
composed of the following 3 parts:
(a) Sensors: These sense the vehicle speed and throttle position and send this data to the ECM in the form
of electronic signals.
(b) ECM: This determines the shift and lock–up timing based upon the signals from the sensors.
(c) Actuators: Solenoid valves divert hydraulic pressure from one circuit of the hydraulic control unit to
another, thus controlling shifting and lock–up timing.
AX–8
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
AX0EQ–02
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09240–00020
Wire Gauge Set
09330–00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
09350–32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
09308–10010
Oil Seal Puller
(09351–32020)
Stator Stopper
(09351–32032)
Counter Driven Gear Holding Tool
(09351–32040)
No.1 Piston Spring Compressor
(09351–32050)
Snap Ring Expander
(09351–32061)
Oil Pump Puller
(09351–32070)
No.2 Piston Spring Compressor
(09351–32080)
Lock Nut Wrench
(09351–32090)
Oil Seal Remover & Replacer
(09351–32100)
Drive Pinion Bearing Replacer
AX–9
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
(09351–32111)
Side Bearing Race Replacer
(09351–32120)
Overdrive Bearing Replacer
(09351–32130)
Handle
(09351–32140)
Oil Seal Replacer
(09351–32150)
Oil Seal Replacer
(09351–32190)
Measure Terminal
(09351–32200)
No.3 Piston Spring Compressor
09502–10012
Differential Side Bearing Puller
09564–32011
Differential Preload Adaptor
09710–28020
Front Suspension Bushing Tool
Set
(09710–08040)
09950–00020
Bushing Replacer
Bearing Remover
AX0ER–02
RECOMMENDED TOOL
09031–00030
Pin Punch .
AX–10
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
AX0ES–02
EQUIPMENT
Feeler gauge
Vernier calipers
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Straight edge
Torque wrench
AX0ET–02
LUBRICANT
Liters
Item
US qts
Imp qts
Automatic Transaxle Fluid
(w/o Differential Fluid)
5.6
Dry Fill
5.9
4.9
ATF DEXRON ® @@@@@: [g 2]
2.5
Drain and Refill
2.6
Differential Fluid
Clacification
2.2
1.6
1.7
1.4
ATF DEXRON ® @@@@@: [g 2]
AX0EU–02
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00090
Seal Packing 1281,
THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
(FIPG)
08833–00070
Adhesive 1324,
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
AX–11
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX0GS–02
COMPONENTS
AX–12
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–14
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–15
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX0EW–02
SEPARATE BASIC SUBASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Remove the manual shift lever.
(b) Pry off the lock washer and remove the manual valve
shaft nut.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and pull out the park/neutral position
switch.
2. REMOVE UNION AND ELBOW
(a) Using the open end wrench, remove the union and elbow.
(b) Remove the O–rings from the union and elbow.
3. REMOVE SL SOLENOID
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and SL solenoid.
4.
5.
REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE RETAINING PLATE
REMOVE SOLENOID WIRE RETAINING BOLT
6. REMOVE COVER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and cover bracket.
AX–16
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Remove the cover.
7. REMOVE OIL PAN AND GASKET
(a) Remove the 15 bolts.
(b) Remove the oil pan by lifting transaxle case.
NOTICE: Do not turn the transaxle over as this will contaminate the valve body with the foreign materials in the bottom
of the oil pan.
(c)
Place the transaxle on wooden blocks to prevent damage
to the tube bracket.
8.
EXAMINE PARTICLES IN PAN
Remove the magnets and use them to collect any steel
chips. Look carefully at the chips and particles in the oil
pan and on the magnets to anticipate what type of wear
you will find in the transmission:
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non–magnetic): bushing wear
9.
DISCONNECT NO.1 AND NO.2 SOLENOID CONNECTORS
10. REMOVE TUBE BRACKET AND OIL STRAINER
AX–17
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
11. REMOVE OIL TUBES
Pry up both tube ends with a large screwdriver and remove the 4 tubes.
12. REMOVE MANUAL DETENT SPRING
13. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE AND MANUAL VALVE
BODY
14. REMOVE VALVE BODY
(a) Remove the 12 bolts.
15. REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE AND SOLENOID WIRING FROM CASE
16. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
AX–18
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
17. REMOVE ACCUMULATOR PISTON AND SPRINGS
(a) Loosen the 5 bolts one turn at a time until the spring tension is released.
(b) Remove the cover and gasket.
(c) Remove the piston and spring for C1 and C2.
(d) Remove the O–rings.
(e) Pop out piston C1 into a rag, using low–pressure compressed air 98 kPa (1 kgf/cm2, 14 psi).
(f) Remove the 2 O–rings from the B2 piston.
18. MEASURE PISTON STROKE OF SECOND COAST
BRAKE
(a) Apply a small amount of paint to the piston rod at the point
it meets the case.
(b) Using SST, measure the piston stroke while applying and
releasing compressed air (392 – 785 kPa, 4 – 8 kgf/cm2,
57 – 114 psi).
SST 09240–00020
Piston stroke:
1.5 – 3.0 mm (0.059 – 0.118 in.)
If the piston stroke exceeds the limit, replace the piston
rod or brake band.
AX–19
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
19. REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
(a) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(b) Remove the cover.
(c) Remove the piston and outer return spring.
(d) Remove the O–ring from the cover.
20. REMOVE OIL PUMP AND DIRECT CLUTCH
NOTICE: Before removing the oil pump, remove the second coast brake piston.
(a) Remove the 7 bolts.
(b) Using SST, pull out the oil pump from the transaxle case.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32061)
21. REMOVE OIL PUMP AND DIRECT CLUTCH
While holding the input shaft, grasp the pump stator shaft
and pull the oil pump and direct clutch together out of the
transaxle case.
NOTICE: Push the second coast brake band into the case,
being careful not to catch it on the direct clutch drum.
AX–20
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
22. REMOVE DIRECT CLUTCH FROM OIL PUMP
23. BE CAREFUL WHEN REMOVING RACE BEHIND OIL
PUMP
24. REMOVE CLUTCH DRUM THRUST WASHER
25. REMOVE FORWARD CLUTCH
26. REMOVE BEARINGS AND RACES FROM FORWARD
CLUTCH
27. REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND
(a) Push the pin with a small screwdriver and remove it from
the bolt hole of the oil pump mounting.
(b) Remove the brake band.
28. REMOVE FRONT PLANETARY RING GEAR
AX–21
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
29. REMOVE BEARING RACES FROM FRONT PLANETARY RING GEAR
30. REMOVE PLANETARY GEAR
31. REMOVE RACES AND BEARINGS FROM PLANETARY GEAR
32. REMOVE SUN GEAR, SUN GEAR INPUT DRUM, SECOND BRAKE HUB AND NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
33. STAND TRANSMISSION CASE UP AND REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND GUIDE
AX–22
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
34. REMOVE SNAP RING HOLDING SECOND BRAKE
DRUM TO CASE
35. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE DRUM
If the brake drum is difficult to remove, lightly tap it with a
wooden block.
36. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE PISTON RETURN SPRING
37. REMOVE PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
38. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE DRUM GASKET
AX–23
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
39. REMOVE SNAP RING HOLDING NO.2 ONE–WAY
CLUTCH OUTER RACE TO CASE
40. REMOVE NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND REAR PLANETARY GEAR
41. BE CAREFUL WHEN REMOVING THRUST WASHERS
FROM BOTH SIDES OF PLANETARY CARRIER
42. REMOVE REAR PLANETARY RING GEAR
43. REMOVE BEARINGS AND RACES
AX–24
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
44. CHECK OPERATION OF FIRST AND REVERSE
BRAKE PISTON
Apply compressed air into the case passage and confirm
that the piston moves.
If the piston does not move, disassemble and inspect.
45. REMOVE SNAP RING HOLDING FLANGE TO CASE
46. REMOVE FLANGES, PLATES AND DISCS
47. TURN TRANSAXLE CASE AROUND
48. REMOVE 11 BOLTS HOLDING OVERDRIVE UNIT TO
TRANSAXLE CASE
49. REMOVE OVERDRIVE UNIT WITH ALL PARTS
(a) Tap on the overdrive case circumference with a plastic
hammer to remove the unit from the transaxle case.
(b) Remove the overdrive planetary gear and counter gear if
they remained in the transaxle.
HINT: The overdrive unit is heavy, so be careful not to
drop it.
AX–25
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
Remove the overdrive brake drum from the transaxle
case.
(d) Remove the overdrive planetary gear and counter gear if
they remain in the transaxle.
50. REMOVE OVERDRIVE CLUTCH APPLY GASKET AND
OVERDRIVE BRAKEAPPLY GASKET
51. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST, and compress the return springs evenly by
tightening the bolt gradually.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32040)
(b) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(c) Remove SST.
(d) Remove the return spring from the case.
AX–26
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
52. REMOVE FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE PISTON
(a) Apply compressed air into the passage of the case to remove the piston.
HINT: Hold the piston so it is not slanted and blow with the
gun slightly away from the oil hole.
(b) If the piston does not pop out with compressed air, use
needle–nose pliers to remove it.
(c)
Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
53. REMOVE PARKING LOCK PAWL BRACKET
54. REMOVE PARKING LOCK ROD
AX–27
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
55. REMOVE PIN, SPRING AND PARKING LOCK PAWL
56. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE SHAFT
(a) Remove the retaining spring.
(b) Using a hammer and chisel, pry and turn the collar.
(c) Using a hammer and punch, drive out the pin.
(d) Slide out the shaft and remove the manual valve lever
from the case.
57. REMOVE MANUAL SHAFT OIL SEAL
Remove the oil seal with a screwdriver.
AX–28
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX0EX–02
DISASSEMBLY OF DIFFERENTIAL
1.
REMOVE CARRIER COVER
2.
MEASURE TOTAL PRELOAD
Using a torque meter, measure the total preload, and note
the measurement value.
3.
MEASURE BACKLASH OF SIDE GEAR
Measure each side gear backlash while holding one pinion toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE LH BEARING RETAINER
Remove the 6 bolts.
Tap the retainer with a plastic hammer to remove it.
Remove the O–ring from the retainer.
5.
REMOVE RH SIDE BEARING CAP
Remove the 2 bolts and the side bearing cap.
AX–29
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
6.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE, OUTER RACE AND
ADJUSTING SHIM
Remove the differential case, the outer race and the adjusting shim from the case.
7.
MEASURE DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
Using a torque meter, measure the drive pinion preload.
Preload (at starting):
Reused bearing
0.5 – 0.8 N·m (5 – 8 kgf·cm, 4.3 – 6.9 in.·lbf)
The total preload measured in step 2 minus the drive pinion preload equals 0.1 – 0.2 N·m (1.5 – 2.0 kgf·cm, 1.3 –
1.7in.·lbf).
If the result is not within this specification, the side bearing
preload is bad.
8. REMOVE DRIVE PINION CAP
(a) Remove the drive pinion cap installation bolt.
(b) Using a screwdriver, push out the drive pinion cap.
9. REMOVE COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR
(a) Using a chisel, loosen the staked part of the nut.
AX–30
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Install SST onto the gear.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32032)
(c) Using SST to hold the gear, remove the nut.
SST 09330–00021
(d) Using SST, remove the gear and bearing.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32061)
10. REMOVE OUTER RACE FROM CASE
Using SST, remove the outer race.
SST 09350–32014 (09308–10010)
11. REMOVE OIL SLINGER
12. REMOVE SPACER
AX–31
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
13. REMOVE ROTOR SENSOR
14. REMOVE DRIVE PINION
(a) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(b) Install a brass bar into case hole to tap out the drive pinion.
(c) Tap the drive pinion and remove the bearing cage from
the bore.
15. REMOVE BEARING CAGE FROM DRIVE PINION
16. REMOVE O–RING FROM BEARING CAGE
AX–32
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS
COMPONENT PARTS
AX0EY–02
GENERAL NOTES
The instructions here are organized so that you work on only one component group at a time.
This will help avoid confusion from similar–looking parts of different subassemblies being on your workbench at the same time.
The component groups are inspected and repaired from the converter housing side.
As much as possible, complete the inspection, repair and assembly before proceeding to the next component group. If a component group cannot be assembled because parts are being ordered, be sure
to keep all parts of that group in a separate container while proceeding with disassembly, inspection,
repair and assembly of other component groups.
Recommended fluid for the automatic transaxle:
DEXRON ® @@@@@: [g 2]
GENERAL CLEANING NOTES:
1. All disassembled parts should be washed clean and any fluid passages and holes blown through with
compressed air.
2. When using compressed air to dry parts, always aim away from yourself to prevent accidentally spraying automatic transmission fluid or kerosene in your face.
3. The recommended automatic transaxle fluid or kerosene should be used for cleaning.
PARTS ARRANGEMENT:
1. After cleaning, the parts should be arranged in the correct order to allow efficient inspection, repairs,
and reassembly.
2. When disassembling a valve body, be sure to keep each valve together with the corresponding spring.
3. New brakes and clutches that are to be used for replacement must be soaked in transaxle fluid for at
least 15 minutes before assembly.
GENERAL ASSEMBLY:
1. All oil seal rings, clutch discs, clutch plates, rotating parts, and sliding surfaces should be coated with
transmission fluid prior to reassembly.
2. All gaskets and rubber O–rings should be replaced.
3. Make sure that the ends of a snap ring are not aligned with one of the cutouts and are installed in the
groove correctly.
4. If a worn bushing is to be replaced, the subassembly containing that bushing must be replaced.
5. Check thrust bearings and races for wear or damage. Replace if necessary.
6. Use petroleum jelly to keep parts in place.
AX–33
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
SECOND COAST BRAKE
AX0EZ–02
COMPONENTS
SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
DISASSEMBLY
1.
AX0F0–02
REMOVE OIL SEAL RING
Remove the oil seal ring from the piston.
2. REMOVE PISTON ROD
(a) Remove the E–ring while pushing the piston with needle–
nose pliers.
AX–34
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
(b) Remove the spring, washer and piston rod.
AX0F1–02
SECOND COAST BRAKE INSPECTION
INSPECT BRAKE BAND
If the lining of the brake band is peeling off or discolored,
or even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace the brake band.
AX0F2–02
SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
ASSEMBLY
1.
SELECT PISTON ROD
If the band is OK, but the piston stroke is not within the
standard value, select a new piston rod.
Piston stroke:
1.5 – 3.0 mm (0.059 – 0.118 in.)
There are 2 lengths of piston rod.
Piston rod length:
72.9 mm (2.870 in.)
71.4 mm (2.811 in.)
2. INSTALL PISTON ROD
(a) Install the washer and spring to the piston rod.
(b) Install an E–ring while pushing the piston.
AX–35
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
3. INSTALL OIL SEAL RING
(a) Apply ATF to the oil seal ring.
(b) Install the oil seal ring to the piston.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends more than necessary.
AX–36
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OIL PUMP
OIL PUMP
AX0F3–02
COMPONENTS
OIL PUMP DISASSEMBLY
AX0F4–02
1.
REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
Remove the 2 oil seal rings from the stator shaft back
side.
2.
REMOVE THRUST WASHER FROM STATOR SHAFT
BACK SIDE
AX–37
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OIL PUMP
3.
REMOVE STATOR SHAFT
Remove the 11 bolts and stator shaft.
Keep the gears in assembly order.
4.
REMOVE FRONT OIL SEAL
Pry off the oil seal with a screwdriver.
AX0F5–02
OIL PUMP BUSHING INSPECTION
1.
CHECK BODY CLEARANCE OF DRIVEN GEAR
Push the driven gear to one side of the body.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard body clearance:
0.07 – 0.15 mm (0.0028 – 0.0059 in.)
Maximum body clearance:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
2.
If the body clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
CHECK TIP CLEARANCE OF DRIVEN GEAR
Measure between the driven gear teeth and the crescent–shaped part of the pump body.
Standard tip clearance:
0.11 – 0.14 mm (0.0043 – 0.0055 in.)
Maximum tip clearance:
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than the maximum, replace
the oil pump body subassembly.
3.
CHECK SIDE CLEARANCE OF BOTH GEARS
Using a steel straightedge and a feeler gauge, measure
the side clearance of both gears.
Standard side clearance:
0.02 – 0.05 mm (0.0008 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum side clearance:
0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
There are 3 different thicknesses for drive and driven
gears.
AX–38
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OIL PUMP
Drive and driven gear thickness
Mark
Thickness
mm (in.)
A
9.440 – 9.456 (0.3717 – 0.3723)
B
9.456 – 9.474 (0.3723 – 0.3730)
C
9.474 – 9.490 (0.3730 – 0.3736)
If the thickest gear cannot make the side clearance within
standard specification, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
4.
CHECK OIL PUMP BODY BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
oil pump body bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
38.18 mm (1.5031 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
5.
CHECK STATOR SHAFT BUSHINGS
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
stator shaft bushings.
Maximum inside diameter:
Front side
21.57 mm (0.8492 in.)
Rear side
27.07 mm (1.0657 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the stator shaft.
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
AX0F6–02
1.
INSTALL FRONT OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal. The seal
end should be flush with the outer edge of the pump body.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32140)
2.
INSTALL DRIVEN GEAR AND DRIVE GEAR
Make sure the top of the gears are facing upward.
AX–39
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
3.
4.
–
OIL PUMP
INSTALL STATOR SHAFT ONTO PUMP BODY
Align the stator shaft with each bolt hole.
TIGHTEN 11 STATOR SHAFT BOLTS
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
5. INSTALL THRUST WASHER
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly.
(b) Align the tab of the washer with the hollow of the pump
body.
6.
INSTALL 2 OIL SEAL RINGS ON OIL PUMP
Install 2 oil seal rings to the stator shaft groove, then snug
them down by squeezing their ends together.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends too much.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
7.
CHECK PUMP DRIVE GEAR ROTATION
Turn the drive gear with screwdrivers and make sure that
it rotates smoothly.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
AX–40
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
DIRECT CLUTCH
AX0GT–02
COMPONENTS
DIRECT CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
AX0F7–02
1. CHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Install the direct clutch on the oil pump.
(b) Set a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the direct clutch piston stroke while applying
and releasing compressed air (392 – 785 kPa, 4 – 8 kgf/
cm2, 57 – 114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
1.11 – 1.44 mm (0.0437 – 0.0567 in.)
If the piston stroke is greater than the maximum inspect
each component.
AX–41
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
3.
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
REMOVE SNAP RING FROM CLUTCH DRUM
REMOVE FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
4. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the
springs with a shop press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(b) Remove the snap ring with the snap ring pliers.
(c)
Remove the piston return spring.
5. REMOVE CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Install the direct clutch onto the oil pump.
(b) Apply compressed air to the oil pump to remove the piston. (if the piston does not come out completely, use
needle–nose pliers to remove it).
(c) Remove the direct clutch from the oil pump.
(d) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX–42
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
AX0F8–02
DIRECT CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying lowpressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
3.
CHECK DIRECT CLUTCH BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
direct clutch bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
47.07 mm (1.8531 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the direct clutch.
DIRECT CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
AX0F9–02
1. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON IN DIRECT CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install new O–rings to the piston. Coat the O–rings with
ATF.
(b) Being careful not to damage the O–rings, press the piston
into the drum with the cup side up.
2. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place the return spring and snap ring onto the piston.
(b) Place SST on the spring retainer, and compress the return spring with a shop press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(c) Install the snap ring with the snap ring pliers. Be sure the
end gap of snap ring is not aligned with the spring retainer
claw.
AX–43
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
3. INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
(a) Install plates and discs.
Install in order: P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–P–D
(b) Install the flange with the flat end facing downward.
4.
INSTALL SNAP RING
Check that the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of the cutouts.
5. RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Install the direct clutch on the oil pump.
(b) Set a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the direct clutch piston stroke while applying
and releasing compressed air (392 – 785 kPa, 4 – 8 kgf/
cm2, 57 – 114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
1.11 – 1.44 mm (0.0437 – 0.0567 in.)
If the piston stroke is non–standard, select another
flange.
HINT: There are 2 different flange thickness.
Flange thickness:
2.60 mm (0.1024 in.)
3.00 mm (0.1181 in.)
AX–44
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
FORWARD CLUTCH
AX0FA–02
COMPONENTS
FORWARD CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
1.
AX0FB–02
CHECK PISTON STROKE OF FORWARD CLUTCH
Set a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the forward clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392 – 785 kPa, 4 – 8
kgf/cm2, 57 – 114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
1.41 – 1.82 mm (0.0555 – 0.0717 in.)
If the piston stroke is greater than the maximum inspect
the each component.
AX–45
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
2.
REMOVE SNAP RING FROM CLUTCH DRUM
3.
REMOVE FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
4. REMOVE RETURN SPRINGS
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the
springs with a shop press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(b) Remove the snap ring with the snap ring pliers.
(c)
Remove the piston return spring.
5. REMOVE CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Apply compressed air into the oil passage to remove the
piston.
If the piston does not come out, use needle–nose pliers
to remove it.
AX–46
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
6.
IF NECESSARY, REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
Remove the 2 oil seal rings from the shaft.
AX0FC–02
FORWARD CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying lowpressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX0FD–02
FORWARD CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OIL SEAL RINGS
Install the 2 oil seal rings to the shaft.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends more than necessary.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
AX–47
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
2. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON TO CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install the 2 new O–rings to the piston.
(b) Coat the O–rings with ATF.
(c) Press the piston into the drum with the cup side up, being
careful not to damage the O–rings.
3. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRINGS
(a) Place the piston return spring and snap ring onto the piston.
(b) Place SST on the piston return spring, and compress the
springs with a shop press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(c) Install the snap ring with snap ring pliers.
Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
the spring retainer claw.
4. INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
(a) Install the plates and discs.
Install in order: P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D
(b) Install the flange with the flat end facing downward.
5.
INSTALL SNAP RING
Check that the end gap of snap ring is not aligned with one
of the cutouts.
AX–48
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
6.
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF FORWARD CLUTCH
Set a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the forward clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392 – 785 kPa, 4 – 8
kgf/cm2, 57 – 114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
1.41 – 1.82 mm (0.0555 – 0.0717 in.)
If the piston stroke is less than the limit, parts may be misassembled and reinstall them.
If the piston stroke is non–standard, select another
flange.
HINT: There are 5 different flange thickness.
Flange thickness:
2.8 mm (0.110 in.)
3.0 mm (0.118 in.)
3.2 mm (0.126 in.)
3.4 mm (0.134 in.)
3.6 mm (0.142 in.)
AX–49
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
AX0FE–02
COMPONENTS
ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND SUN GEAR
DISASSEMBLY
AX0FF–02
1.
CHECK OPERATION OF ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Hold the sun gear and turn the hub. The hub should turn
freely clockwise and should lock counterclockwise.
2.
REMOVE SECOND BRAKE HUB AND ONE–WAY
CLUTCH FRONT SUN GEAR
While turning the hub clockwise, remove the one–way
clutch from the sun gear.
AX–50
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
3.
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
REMOVE THRUST WASHER FROM SUN GEAR INPUT
DRUM
4. REMOVE SUN GEAR FROM DRUM
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring from the
drum.
(b) Remove the sun gear from the drum.
5.
REMOVE SHAFT SNAP RING
Using snap ring pliers, remove the shaft snap ring from
the sun gear.
ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND SUN GEAR
ASSEMBLY
AX0FG–02
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SHAFT SNAP RING TO SUN GEAR
INSTALL SUN GEAR TO DRUM
Install the sun gear to the drum.
Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring to the drum.
3.
INSTALL THRUST WASHER TO SUN GEAR INPUT
DRUM
AX–51
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
4.
5.
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
INSTALL ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND SECOND BRAKE
HUB ON SUN GEAR
While turning the hub clockwise, slide the one–way clutch
onto the sun gear.
RECHECK OPERATION OF ONE–WAY CLUTCH
AX0FH–02
PLANETARY RING GEAR INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT RING GEAR FLANGE BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
flange bushing.
Standard inside diameter:
19.025 – 19.050 mm (0.7490 – 0.7500 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the flange.
2. REMOVE RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the flange from the ring gear.
3. INSTALL RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Position the flange into the ring gear.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
AX–52
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
AX0FJ–02
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR INSPECTION
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.20 – 0.50 mm (0.0079 – 0.0197 in.)
AX–53
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND BRAKE
SECOND BRAKE
AX0FK–02
COMPONENTS
AX0FL–02
SECOND BRAKE PISTON DISASSEMBLY
REMOVE SECOND BRAKE PISTON
(a) Apply compressed air to the oil hole to remove the piston.
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX–54
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND BRAKE
AX0FM–02
SECOND BRAKE INSPECTION
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surface of the discs, plates and flange
are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX0FN–02
SECOND BRAKE PISTON ASSEMBLY
INSTALL PISTON
(a) Coat a new O–ring with ATF.
(b) Install the 2 O–rings on the piston.
(c)
Press the piston into the drum, being careful not to damage the O–rings.
AX–55
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
AX0FP–02
COMPONENTS
ONE–WAY CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
AX0FQ–02
1.
CHECK OPERATION OF ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Hold the outer race and turn the hub. The hub should turn
freely counterclockwise and should lock clockwise.
2.
SEPARATE ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND PLANETARY
GEAR
REMOVE THRUST WASHERS
Remove the 2 thrust washers from both sides of the planetary gear.
3.
AX–56
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
4. REMOVE ONE–WAY CLUTCH FROM OUTER RACE
(a) Remove the 2 snap rings and retainers from both sides.
(b) Remove the one–way clutch from the outer race.
AX0FR–02
REAR PLANETARY GEAR INSPECTION
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.20 – 0.50 mm (0.0079 – 0.0197 in.)
AX0FS–02
ONE–WAY CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install the one–way clutch into the outer race, facing the
flanged side of the one–way clutch toward the shiny side
of the outer race.
(b) Install the 2 retainers and snap rings to both sides.
2.
INSTALL PLANETARY GEAR INTO ONE–WAY
CLUTCH
Install the planetary gear into the one–way clutch, facing
the inner race of the planetary gear toward the black side
of the one–way clutch outer race.
AX–57
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
3.
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
CHECK OPERATION OF ONE–WAY CLUTCH
4. INSTALL THRUST WASHERS
(a) Coat the 2 thrust washers with petroleum jelly.
(b) Align the tab of the washers with the hollow of the carrier.
AX0FT–02
RING GEAR FLANGE REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the flange from the ring gear.
2. INSTALL RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Position the flange into the ring gear.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
AX–58
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
AX0FU–02
COMPONENTS
AX0FV–02
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE INSPECTION
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGES
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flanges are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembly new discs, soak them in ATF for at
least 15 minutes.
AX–59
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX0FW–02
COMPONENTS
AX–60
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX0FX–02
OVERDRIVE BRAKE DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) While pushing the return spring, remove the snap ring
with a screwdriver.
(b) Remove the piston return spring.
2.
REMOVE CUSHION PLATE, PLATES, DISCS AND
FLANGE
3.
REMOVE PISTON FROM DRUM
Apply compressed air to oil hole to remove the piston.
HINT: Blow with the gun slightly away from the oil hole,
and be careful that the piston does not tilt.
4.
REMOVE O–RINGS
Remove the inner and outer O–rings from the piston.
AX–61
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX0FY–02
OVERDRIVE BRAKE INSPECTION
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX0FZ–02
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
DISASSEMBLY
1.
CHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
Using a dial indicator, measure the piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392 – 785 kPa, 4 –
8 kgf/cm2, 57– 114 psi).
Piston stroke:
1.21 – 1.91 mm (0.0476 – 0.0752 in.)
If the piston stroke is greater than the maximum, inspect
the each component.
2.
REMOVE OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH FROM CASE
AX–62
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
3.
REMOVE BEARING AND RACE FROM CLUTCH
DRUM AND CASE
4.
REMOVE SNAP RING WITH SCREWDRIVER
5.
REMOVE FLANGES, DISCS AND PLATES
6. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the spring
with a shop press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070, 09351–32200)
(b) Remove the snap ring.
(c)
Remove the piston return spring.
AX–63
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
7. REMOVE PISTON FROM CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install the clutch drum of the case.
(b) Apply compressed air to the pressure apply hole of the
case.
(c) Remove the piston from the clutch drum.
If the piston does not come out completely, use needle–
nose pliers to remove it.
(d) Remove the clutch drum from the case.
8.
REMOVE O–RINGS
Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX0G0–02
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying lowpressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGES
Check that the sliding surfaces of discs, plates and
flanges are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
3.
CHECK DIRECT CLUTCH BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
two direct clutch bushings.
Maximum inside diameter:
22.09 mm (0.8697 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the direct clutch drum.
AX–64
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX0G1–02
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Install new O–rings to the piston. Coat the O–rings with
ATF.
(b) Press the piston into the drum with the cup side up, being
careful not to damage the O–ring.
2. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Install the return spring and set snap ring in place.
(b) Place SST on the spring retainer, and compress the
spring with a shop press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070, 09351–32200)
(c) Install the snap ring with a screwdriver. Be sure end gap
of snap ring is aligned with the groove of the clutch drum.
3.
INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
Install in order: P=Plate D=Disc
Flange – D – P – D – Flange
AX–65
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
4.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
INSTALL SNAP RING
Be sure end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the
groove of the clutch drum.
5. INSTALL BEARING AND RACE
(a) Coat the bearing with petroleum jelly and install it facing
the race side downward to the clutch drum.
Bearing:
Outer diameter
46.3 mm (1.823 in.)
Inner diameter
26.2 mm (1.031 in.)
(b) Coat the race with petroleum jelly and install it to thecase.
Race:
Outer diameter
43.0 mm (1.693 in.)
Inner diameter
24.5 mm (0.965 in.)
6.
INSTALL DIRECT CLUTCH ON CASE
7.
RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
Using a dial indicator, measure the piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392 – 785 kPa, 4 –
8 kgf/cm2, 57– 114 psi).
Piston stroke:
1.21 – 1.91 mm (0.0476 – 0.0752 in.)
AX–66
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX0G2–02
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR DISASSEMBLY
1. CHECK OPERATION OF ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) While turning the overdrive gear clockwise, install the overdrive direct clutch into the one–way clutch.
(b) Hold the overdrive direct clutch and turn the intermediate
shaft. The shaft should turn freely clockwise and should
lock counterclockwise.
(c) Remove the overdrive direct clutch.
2. CHECK COUNTER DRIVE GEAR PRELOAD
(a) Hold the intermediate shaft in a vise with soft jaws.
(b) Using a tension gauge, measure the preload.
Preload (at starting):
9 – 15 N (920 – 1,530 gf, 2.0 – 3.4 lbf)
HINT: Turn the counter drive gear right and left several
times before measuring the preload.
3. REMOVE RETAINING PLATE
(a) Remove the snap ring with a screwdriver.
(b) Remove the retaining plate.
4.
REMOVE ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND OUTER RACE
AX–67
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
5.
REMOVE NO.3 OVERDRIVE PLANETARY THRUST
WASHER
6.
REMOVE ONE–WAY CLUTCH FROM OUTER RACE
Note the direction of the one–way clutch.
7.
REMOVE PLUGS FROM PLANETARY GEAR
Remove the 4 plugs with a magnetic finger.
HINT: Be careful not to lose them.
8. REMOVE ADJUSTING NUT AND WASHER
(a) Pry off the locking washer with chisel.
(b) Using SST, loosen the adjusting nut.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32080)
(c) Remove the adjusting nut and washer.
AX–68
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
9.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
REMOVE INTERMEDIATE SHAFT BEARING
Using SST, press out the bearing from the shaft.
SST 09950–00020
10. REMOVE COUNTER DRIVE GEAR AND FRONT
BEARING
Press out the gear and bearing together.
11. REMOVE REAR BEARING
Using SST, press out the bearing.
SST 09950–00020
12. REMOVE OVERDRIVE PLANETARY RING GEAR
FROM COUNTER DRIVEGEAR
(a) While pulling up the ring gear, compress the snap ring
with needle–nose pliers and remove it from the groove.
(b) Remove the ring gear from the counter drive gear.
13. REMOVE OUTER RACES FROM COUNTER DRIVE
GEAR
Drive out the 2 races with a brass bar and hammer.
AX–69
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
14. REMOVE SNAP RING FROM COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
AX0G3–02
OVERDRIVE PLANETARY GEAR
INSPECTION
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.20 – 0.50 mm (0.0079 – 0.0197 in.)
AX0GU–02
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL SNAP RING INTO COUNTER GEAR
Install the snap ring with a screwdriver.
2.
INSTALL OUTER RACES INTO COUNTER DRIVE
GEAR
Using SST, press in the 2 outer races to the gear both
side.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120, 09351–32150)
HINT: Press in the 2 outer races until they touch the snap
ring. Tap the races in straight, so that they do not tilt.
3.
INSTALL OVERDRIVE PLANETARY RING GEAR INTO
COUNTER DRIVEGEAR
While pushing down the ring gear, squeeze the snap ring
end with a needle–nose pliers, and install it into the
groove.
HINT: When the snap ring is fully seated, the end will be
free.
AX–70
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
4.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
INSTALL REAR BEARING
Using SST, press in the bearing onto the shaft.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
HINT: Press in the bearing until the side surface of the inner race touches the shaft.
5.
INSTALL COUNTER DRIVE GEAR AND FRONT BEARING
(a) Install the gear onto the shaft, and mesh the ring gear with
the planetary pinions.
(b) Place the front bearing onto the shaft.
HINT: Hold the ring gear to prevent it from falling.
(c)
Using SST, press in the bearing until there is slight play
between the bearings.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
6.
INSTALL INTERMEDIATE SHAFT BEARING
Using SST, press in the bearing until it slightly touches the
front bearing of the counter drive gear.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
HINT: The counter drive gear can be turned lightly.
7.
PLACE NEW LOCKING WASHER AND ADJUSTING
NUT ONTO INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
AX–71
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
8. ADJUST PRELOAD OF COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) Place SST onto the adjusting nut and hold the shaft in a
vise with soft jaws.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32080)
(b) Tighten the adjusting nut until the following gear starting
load occurs with a tension gauge.
Preload (at starting):
9 – 15 N (920 – 1,530 gf, 2.0 – 3.4 lbf)
(c)
9.
HINT: Turn the counter drive gear right and left several
times before measuring the preload.
Lock the adjusting nut with one tab on locking washer.
Bend the locking washer tab until it is even with the adjusting nut groove.
INSTALL PINION SHAFT PLUGS
Install the 4 plugs into the pinion shaft.
10. INSTALL NO.3 OVERDRIVE PLANETARY THRUST
WASHER
Install the thrust washer, facing the groove toward the overdrive case.
11. ASSEMBLE OVERDRIVE ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install the one–way clutch into the outer race.
(b) Install a retainer on both sides of the one–way clutch.
AX–72
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
12. INSTALL OVERDRIVE ONE–WAY CLUTCH INTO HUB
Be sure that the one–way clutch is installed in the correct
direction.
13. INSTALL RETAINING PLATE
(a) Place the retaining plate into the hub.
(b) Install the snap ring with a screwdriver.
14. CHECK OPERATION OF ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) While turning the overdrive gear clockwise, install the overdrive direct clutch into the one–way clutch.
(b) Hold the overdrive direct clutch and turn the intermediate
shaft. The shafts should turn freely clockwise and should
lock counterclockwise.
(c) Remove the overdrive direct clutch.
AX–73
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX0G4–02
OVERDRIVE CASE DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE C0 ACCUMULATOR PISTON FROM OVERDRIVE CASE
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the retaining plate and two springs.
(c) Remove the accumulator piston.
(d) Remove the O–ring from the piston.
2.
REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
Spread the 2 rings apart and remove them.
OVERDRIVE CASE INSPECTION
INSPECT OVERDRIVE CASE BEARING
Check that the bearing turns smoothly with your finger.
AX–74
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX0G5–02
OVERDRIVE CASE ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OIL SEAL RINGS ON OVERDRIVE CASE
Install the oil seal rings to the O/D case groove, then snug
them down by squeezing their ends together.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
INSTALL C0 ACCUMULATOR PISTON OF OVERDRIVE CLUTCH
(a) Install a new O–ring to the accumulator piston. Coat the
O–ring with ATF.
(b) Install the accumulator piston, 2 springs and plate.
(c) Install the snap ring with snap ring pliers.
2.
AX0G6–02
OVERDRIVE BRAKE ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL PISTON INTO DRUM
(a) Install the new O–rings to the piston. Coat the O–rings
with ATF.
(b) Press the piston into the drum, being careful not to damage the O–rings.
2. INSTALL FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
(a) Install the flange, facing the flat end upward.
AX–75
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
(b) Install the discs and plates.
Install in order: P=Plate D=Disc
Flange – D – P – P – D – P
HINT: There are 2 different thickness plates, as shown in
the illustration.
(c)
Install the cushion plate facing the rounded end upward.
3.
INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
4.
INSTALL SNAP RING INTO CASE
Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of the cutouts.
5.
INSTALL OVERDRIVE GEAR ASSEMBLY ONTO
CASE
While turning the overdrive gear clockwise, install the overdrive gear assembly to the case.
If the overdrive gear assembly is properly installed to the
overdrive case, the clearance between them will be about
24 mm (0.94 in.).
AX–76
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
VALVE BODY
AX0G7–02
COMPONENTS
VALVE BODY DISASSEMBLY
1.
AX0G8–02
NOTE THE NUMBERS OF ADJUSTING RINGS
HINT: Count the number of adjusting rings before disassembly of the valve body because the throttle pressure is
changed according to the number. (Some of the valve bodies do not have any adjusting rings).
2. REMOVE SOLENOIDS
(a) Remove the No.1 and No.2 solenoids.
(b) Remove the O–rings from the solenoids.
AX–77
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
3.
–
VALVE BODY
REMOVE UPPER VALVE BODY COVER
Remove the 9 bolts and upper valve body cover.
4.
REMOVE STRAINER GASKETS, PLATE AND SLEEVE
STOPPER FROM UPPER VALVE BODY
(a) Remove the strainer, 2 gaskets and plate.
(b) Remove the sleeve stopper.
5.
REMOVE BOLTS FROM UPPER VALVE BODY
Remove the 3 bolts from the upper valve body.
6. REMOVE LOWER VALVE BODY COVER
(a) Remove the 10 bolts.
(b) Remove the lower valve body cover and gasket.
AX–78
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
7.
REMOVE BOLTS FROM LOWER VALVE BODY
Remove the 3 bolts from lower valve body.
8.
LIFT OFF LOWER VALVE BODY AND PLATE AS
SINGLE UNIT
Hold the plate to the lower valve body and lift off the lower
valve body.
HINT: Be careful that the check balls do not fall out.
REMOVE PLATE AND GASKETS
9.
AX0G9–02
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
1.
POSITION PLATE AND NEW GASKETS ON LOWER
VALVE BODY
Position the new No.2 gasket, the plate and then the new
No.1 gasket on the lower valve body.
HINT: Since No.1 gasket and No.2 gasket are similar use
the illustration below to discriminate between them.
AX–79
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
2.
PLACE LOWER VALVE BODY WITH PLATE AND GASKETS ON UPPER VALVE BODY
HINT: Hold the lower valve body, gaskets and plate securely so they do not separate.
Align each bolt hole in the valve bodies with the gaskets
and plate.
3.
INSTALL AND FINGER TIGHTEN BOLTS IN LOWER
VALVE BODY TO SECURE UPPER VALVE BODY
Install and finger tighten the 3 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the illustration.
4. INSTALL LOWER VALVE BODY COVER
(a) Install the lower valve body cover over the new gasket.
(b) Install and finger tighten the 10 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the illustration.
5.
INSTALL AND FINGER TIGHTEN BOLTS IN UPPER
VALVE BODY
Install and finger tighten the 3 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the illustration.
6.
INSTALL SLEEVE STOPPER
AX–80
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
7.
INSTALL UPPER VALVE BODY COVER GASKETS,
PLATE AND THROTTLE MODULATOR OIL STRAINER
(a) Position a new gasket and plate and then another new
gasket.
HINT: The gaskets are not identical, but can be installed
in any order.
(b) Install the oil strainer onto the gasket.
8. INSTALL UPPER VALVE BODY COVER
(a) Position the upper valve body cover.
(b) Install and finger tighten the 9 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the illustration.
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL SOLENOIDS
Install the new O–rings on the solenoids.
Install the No.1 and No.2 solenoids.
Install and finger tighten the 3 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the illustration.
10. TIGHTEN BOLTS OF UPPER AND LOWER VALVE BODIES
(a) Tighten the 16 bolts in the lower valve body.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
(b) Tighten the 12 bolts in the upper valve body.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
AX–81
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX0GA–02
COMPONENTS
AX–82
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX0GB–02
VALVE BODY SPRINGS SPECIFICATIONS
HINT: During re–assembly please refer to the spring specifications below to help you to discriminate
between the different springs.
Spring (Color)
Free Length / Coil Outer Diameter
mm (in.)
Number of Coils
@@
@@
@:
Throttle Modulator Spring (None)
21.70 / 9.50 (0.8543 / 0.3740)
9.5
Accumulator Control Spring (Yellow)
28.06 / 10.60 (1.1047 / 0.4173)
13.0
Low Coast Modulator Spring (None)
21.60 / 7.90 (0.8504 / 0.3110)
11.5
Down Shift Valve Spring (Yellow)
29.76 / 8.73 (1.1717 / 0.3437)
13.5
[c A]
@@
@@
@:
[c B]
@@
@@
@:
[c C]
@@
@@
@:
[c D]
AX–83
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
@@
@@
@:
Throttle Valve Spring (None)
30.70 / 9.20 (1.2087 / 0.3622)
9.5
20.93 / 8.50 (0.8240 / 0.3364)
10.0
Lock–up Relay Valve spring (Green)
26.56 / 10.20 (1.0457 / 0.4016)
11.5
Cut–back Valve Spring (None)
21.80 / 6.00 (0.8583 / 0.2362)
13.5
[c E]
@@
@@
@:
Second Coast Modulator Valve Spring
(Light Green)
[c F]
@@
@@
@:
[c G]
@@
@@
@:
[c H]
AX–84
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX0GC–02
RETAINERS, PINS, VIBRATING STOPPER AND CHECK BALLS LOCATION
Retainer
Height / Width / Thickness
mm (in.)
@@@@@: [c H]
Throttle Modulator Valve
9.2 / 5.0 / 3.2 (0.362 / 0.197 / 0.126)
@@@@@: [c I]
Accumulator Control Valve
11.5 / 5.0 / 3.2 (0.453 / 0.197 / 0.126)
@@@@@: [c J]
Cut–back Valve
9.2 / 5.0 / 3.2 (0.362 / 0.197 / 0.126)
@@@@@: [c K]
Lock–up Relay Valve
15.0 / 5.0 / 3.2 (0.591 / 0.197 / 0.126)
@@@@@: [c L]
2nd Coast Modulator Valve
15.0 / 5.0 / 3.2 (0.591 / 0.197 / 0.126)
AX–85
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX0GV–02
COMPONENTS
AX–86
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX0GD–02
VALVE BODY SPRINGS SPECIFICATIONS
HINT: During re–assembly please refer to the spring specifications below to help you to discriminate
between the different springs.
Spring (Color)
Free length / Outer diameter
mm (in.)
Number of Coils
@@
@@
@:
Secondary Regulator Valve Spring
43.60 / 10.90 (1.7165 / 0.4291)
11.5
Lock–up Signal Valve Spring (None)
30.00 / 8.20 (1.1811 / 0.3228)
11.5
3–4 Shift Valve Spring (None)
29.27 / 9.70 (1.1524 / 0.3819)
10.5
(None)
[c A]
@@
@@
@:
[c B]
@@
@@
@:
[c C]
AX–87
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
@@
@@
@:
1–2 Shift Valve Spring (None)
29.27 / 9.70 (1.1524 / 0.3819)
10.5
2–3 Shift Valve Spring (None)
29.27 / 9.70 (1.1524 / 0.3819)
10.5
Primary Regulator Valve Spring (None)
66.65 / 18.60 (2.6240 / 0.7323)
12.5
Cooler By–pass Valve Spring (None)
19.90 / 11.00 (0.7835 / 0.4331)
8.5
Pressure Relief Valve Spring (None)
11.20 / 6.40 (0.4409 / 0.2520)
7.5
[c D]
@@
@@
@:
[c E]
@@
@@
@:
[c F]
@@
@@
@:
[c G]
@@
@@
@:
[c H]
AX–88
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX0GE–02
RETAINER, STRAINER AND CHECK BALLS LOCATION
Retainer
Height / Width / Thickness
mm (in.)
@@@@@: [c I]
Primary Regulator Valve
9.2 / 5.0 / 3.2 (0.362 / 0.197 / 0.128)
@@@@@: [c J]
2–3 Shift Valve
8.0 / 6.0 / 3.2 (0.315 / 0.236 / 0.126)
@@@@@: [c K]
1–2 Shift Valve
9.2 / 5.0 / 3.2 (0.362 / 0.197 / 0.126)
@@@@@: [c L]
3–4 Shift Valve
8.0 / 6.0 / 3.2 (0.315 / 0.236 / 0.126)
@@@@@: [c M]
Secondary Regulator Valve
13.0 / 6.0 / 3.2 (0.512 / 0.236 / 0.126)
@@@@@: [c N]
Lock–up Signal Vave
15.0 / 5.0 / 3.2 (0.591 / 0.197 / 0.126)
AX–89
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
AX0GF–02
COMPONENTS
AX–90
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
AX0GG–02
DIFFERENTIAL CASE DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE RING GEAR
(a) Loosen the staked part of the lock plate.
(b) Remove the 8 bolts and locking plates.
(c) Using a copper hammer, tap on the ring gear to remove
it from the case.
2.
REMOVE SIDE BEARINGS
Fasten SST under the bearing above the cutouts on the
speedometer drive gear. Remove the bearing from the
case.
SST 09502–10012
3.
CHECK SIDE GEAR BACKLASH
Using a dial gauge, measure the backlash of each side
gear while holding one pinion toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
4. DISASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Drive out the pinion shaft lock pin from the side on which
the ring gear is installed.
AX–91
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
(b) Remove the pinion shaft from the case.
(c) Remove the 2 pinions and 2 side gears with the 4 thrust
washers.
5.
REMOVE LH OIL SEAL
Using a hammer and screwdriver, remove the oil seal.
6.
REMOVE BEARING OUTER RACE FROM LH SIDE
BEARING RETAINER
Using SST, press out the outer race and shim.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32090)
7.
REMOVE RH OIL SEAL
Using a hammer and screwdriver, remove the oil seal.
AX0GH–02
DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL RH OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal until its surface is flush
with the surface of the case.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 09351–32150)
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
AX–92
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL BEARING OUTER RACE TO LH SIDE BEARING RETAINER
(a) Place the shim onto the retainer.
(b) Using SST, press a new outer race into the retainer.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32111, 09351–32130)
HINT: Use the 2.60 mm (0.1024 in.) thick thim.
3. INSTALL LH OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 09351–32150)
Oil seal drive in depth:
2.7 mm (0.106 in.)
(b) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
4. ASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Install the removed thrust washers to the side gears.
(b) Install the side gears with thrust washers, pinion thrust
washers and pinion gears.
(c)
Install the pinion shaft.
AX–93
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
(d) Check the side gear backlash.
Measure the side gear backlash while holding one pinion
gear toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
Referring to the table below, select thrust washers which
will ensure that the backlash is within specification. Try to
select washers of the same size for both sides.
Thrust washer thickness
mm (in.)
Thickness
Thickness
0.95 (0.0374)
1.10 (0.0433)
1.00 (0.0394)
1.15 (0.0453)
1.05 (0.0413)
1.20 (0.0472)
If the backlash is not within specification, install a thrust
washer of a different thickness.
(e) Using a hammer and punch, drive the lock pin through the
case and hole in the pinion shaft.
(f)
Stake the differential case.
5. INSTALL SIDE BEARINGS
(a) Install the speedometer drive gear onto the differential
case.
(b) Using SST and a press, press in the RH side bearing onto
the differential case.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32090, 09351–32120)
AX–94
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
(c)
Using SST and a press, press in the LH side bearing onto
the differential case.
SST 09710–28020 (09710–08040)
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL RING GEAR
Clean the contact surface of the differential case.
Heat the ring gear to about 100 °C (212 °F) in an oil bath.
Carefully remove the ring gear from the water.
NOTICE: Do not heat the ring gear above 110 °C (230 °F).
(d) Clean the contact surface of the ring gear with cleaning
solvent.
(e) Quickly install the ring gear on the differential case.
(f) Install new locking plates and set bolts. When the ring
gear has cooled sufficiently, tighten the set bolts uniformly
a little at a time. Torque the bolts.
Torque: 97 N·m (985 kgf·cm, 71 ft·lbf)
(g) Using a hammer and drift punch, stake the locking plates.
HINT: Stake one claw flush with the flat surface of the nut.
For the claw contacting the protruding portion of the nut,
stake only the half on the tightening side.
AX0GJ–02
DRIVE PINION DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE DRIVE PINION SHAFT BEARING
Using SST, press out the bearing.
SST 09950–00020
AX–95
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE OIL SEALS FROM CAGE
Using SST, press out the two oil seals together.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32090)
3.
REMOVE SHAFT BEARING OUTER RACE FROM
CAGE
Using a hammer and brass bar, drive out the outer race
from the cage.
4.
REMOVE COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR BEARING
Using SST, press out the bearing.
SST 09950–00020
DRIVE PINION SHAFT ASSEMBLY
1.
AX0GK–02
INSTALL COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR BEARING
Using SST, press in a new bearing.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32090)
2. INSTALL OIL SEALS TO CAGE
(a) Using SST, press in a new oil seal with the lip facing downward.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32090)
Oil seal press in depth (from flat end):
9.5 mm (0.374 in.)
AX–96
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
(b) Measure the oil seal press in depth.
Oil seal press in depth:
4 mm (0.16 in.)
(c)
With the oil seal lip facing upward, use SST to press in a
new oil seal until its end is flush with the surface of the
cage.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32090)
(d) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
3.
INSTALL SHAFT BEARING OUTER RACE TO CAGE
Using SST, press a new outer race into the cage.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32111, 09351–32130)
4.
INSTALL DRIVE PINION SHAFT BEARING
Using SST, press in the bearing.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32100)
5.
PLACE BEARING CAGE ONTO DRIVE PINION SHAFT
Be careful not to damage the oil seal with the splines.
AX–97
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
AX0GL–02
DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING PRELOAD
ADJUSTMENT
1.
PLACE OUTER RACE AND ADJUSTING SHIM ONTO
RH SIDE BEARING
Use the adjusting shim which was removed or one 2.40
mm (0.0945 in.) thick.
2.
PLACE DIFFERENTIAL CASE INTO TRANSAXLE
CASE
Be sure to install the adjusting shim.
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL LH BEARING RETAINER
Do not install the O–ring yet.
Do not coat the bolt threads with sealant yet.
Temporarily tighten the bolts evenly and gradually while
turning the ring gear.
4.
INSTALL RH SIDE BEARING CAP
Tighten the bolts evenly and gradually while turning the
ring gear.
Torque: 72 N·m (730 kgf·cm, 53 ft·lbf)
5.
TIGHTEN LH BEARING RETAINER
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
AX–98
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
6.
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
ADJUST SIDE BEARING PRELOAD
Using SST and a torque meter, measure the preload of
the ring gear.
SST 09564–32011
Preload (at starting):
New bearing
1.0 – 1.6 N·m (10 – 16 kgf·cm, 8.7 – 13.9 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing
0.5 – 0.8 N·m (5 – 8 kgf·cm, 4.3 – 6.9 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within specification, remove the differential case assembly.
Reselect the RH adjusting shim.
mm (in.)
Thickness
Thickness
1.90 (0.0748)
2.40 (0.0945)
1.95 (0.0786)
2.45 (0.0965)
2.00 (0.0787)
2.50 (0.0984)
2.05 (0.0807)
2.55 (0.1004)
2.10 (0.0827)
2.60 (0.1024)
2.15 (0.0846)
2.65 (0.1043)
2.20 (0.0866)
2.70 (0.1063)
2.25 (0.0886)
2.75 (0.1083)
2.30 (0.0906)
2.80 (0.1103)
HINT: The preload will change by about 0.3 – 0.4 N·m (3
– 4kgf·cm, 2.6 – 3.5 in.·lbf) with a change in shim thickness of 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.).
7.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE AND COMPONENT
PARTS
If the preload is adjusted within specification, remove the
bearing retainer, differential case, RH side bearing and
shim.
Be careful not to lose the adjusting shim.
AX–99
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
AX0GW–02
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
Disassembly, inspection and assembly of each component group have been indicated in the preceding
chapter. Before assembly, make sure, again, that all component groups are assembled correctly.
If something wrong is found in a certain component group during assembly, inspect and repair this
group immediately.
Recommended ATF:
DEXRON ® @@@@@: [g 2]
GENERAL INSTALLATION NOTES:
1. The automatic transaxle is composed of highly precision–finished parts, necessitating careful inspection before assembly because even a small nick could cause fluid leakage and affect performance.
2. Before assembling new clutch discs, soak them in automatic transaxle fluid for at least 15 minutes.
3. Apply automatic transaxle fluid on the sliding or rotating surfaces of parts before assembly.
4. Use petroleum jelly to keep small parts in their places.
5. Do not use adhesive cements on gaskets and similar parts.
6. When assembling the transaxle, be sure to use new gaskets and O–rings.
7. Dry all parts with compressed air–never use shop rags.
8. Be sure to install the thrust bearings and races in the correct direction and position.
AX–100
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
BEARING AND RACE DIAMETERS
mm
Front Bearing Race
Thrust Bearing Race
Rear Bearing Race
(in.)
Outer / Inner Diameter
Outer / Inner Diameter
Outer / Inner Diameter
43.0 / 30.5 (1.693 / 1.201)
42.0 / 28.9 (1.654 / 1.138)
42.0 / 27.1 (1.654 / 1.067)
@@
@@
@:
[c A]
AX–101
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
@@
@@
@:
37.9 / 22.0 (1.492 / 0.866)
36.1 / 22.2 (1.421 / 0.874)
35.7 / 23.0 (1.406 / 0.906)
37.9 / 22.0 (1.492 / 0.866)
36.1 / 22.2 (1.421 / 0.874)
35.0 / 19.0 (1.378 / 0.748)
45.0 / 28.0 (1.772 / 1.102)
45.0 / 30.0 (1.772 / 1.181)
–
37.3 / 24.1 (1.469 / 0.949)
37.6 / 24.0 (1.480 / 0.945)
37.6 / 22.2 (1.480 / 0.874)
–
46.3 / 26.2 (1.823 / 1.031)
43.0 / 24.5 (1.693 / 0.965)
[c B]
@@
@@
@:
[c C]
@@
@@
@:
[c D]
@@
@@
@:
[c E]
@@
@@
@:
[c F]
AX0GM–02
DRIVE PINION ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NEW O–RING ONTO BEARING CAGE
2.
INSTALL DRIVE PINION SHAFT INTO CASE
Slightly tap the cage into the case until the groove with the
bore can be see.
HINT: Drive in the bearing cage until the surface of the
bearing cage passes through the groove with the bore.
AX–102
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
3. INSTALL SNAP RING INTO CASE
(a) Using SST, install the snap ring into the groove.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(b) Slightly tap the drive pinion to fit the snap ring into the
groove.
4.
INSTALL ROTOR SENSOR
Install the rotor sensor, facing the magnet outward.
5.
INSTALL OIL SLINGER
Install the oil slinger, facing the lip outward.
6.
INSTALL OUTER RACE
Using SST, drive the outer race into the case.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32100, 09351–32140)
AX–103
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
7.
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
INSTALL NEW SPACER
Always use new spacer.
Install the spacer with the small end first.
8. INSTALL COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR ONTO SHAFT
(a) Place a bar at the drive pinion side and position the outer
end of the bar against a vise or similar.
(b) Using SST, driven in gear onto the shaft until the nut can
be installed on the threads of the shaft.
NOTICE: Be careful not to cause an impact to the transaxle
case.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32140)
9. ADJUST DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Coat the threads and surface of the nut with MP grease.
(b) Using SST to hold the gear, tighten the nut.
Torque: 172 N·m (1,750 kgf·cm, 127 ft·lbf)
SST 09330–00021, 09350–32014 (09351–32032)
(c)
Turn the gear counterclockwise and clockwise several
times.
(d) Using a torque meter, measure the preload of the drive
pinion.
Preload (at starting):
New bearing
1.0 – 1.6 N·m (10 – 16 kgf·cm, 8.7 – 13.9 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing
0.5 – 0.8 N·m (5 – 8 kgf·cm, 4.3 – 6.9 in.·lbf)
AX–104
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
If the preload is greater than specified, replace the
bearing spacer.
If the preload is less than specified, retighten the nut
13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf) at a time until the specified preload is reached.
If the maximum torque is exceeded while retightening the
nut, replace the bearing spacer and repeat the preload
procedure.
Do not back off the nut to reduce the preload.
Maximum torque:
289 N·m (2,950 kgf·cm, 213 ft·lbf)
(e) If the preload is adjusted within specification, make a note
of it.
AX0SX–01
DIFFERENTIAL INSTALLATION
1.
PLACE OUTER RACE AND SELECTED ADJUSTING
SHIM ONTO RH SIDE BEARING
2.
PLACE DIFFERENTIAL CASE INTO CASE
Be sure to install the adjusting shim into place.
3. INSTALL LH BEARING RETAINER
(a) Install a new O–ring.
(b) Position the retainer by tapping it while holding the differential case center with the retainer.
(c) Clean the threads of the bolts and case with white gasoline.
AX–105
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(d) Coat the threads of the bolts with sealer.
Sealer:
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(e) Temporarily tighten the bolts evenly and gradually while
turning the ring gear.
4.
INSTALL RH SIDE BEARING CAP
Tighten the bolts evenly and gradually while turning the
ring gear.
Torque: 72 N·m (730 kgf·cm, 53 ft·lbf)
5.
TIGHTEN LH BEARING RETAINER
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
6.
MEASURE TOTAL PRELOAD
Using a torque meter, measure the total preload of the
drive pinion shaft.
Total preload (at starting):
Add drive pinion preload (See page AX–xx)
New Bearing
0.3 – 0.4 N·m (2.9 – 4.0 kgf·cm, 2.5 – 3.5 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing
0.1 – 0.2 N·m (1.5 – 2.0 kgf·cm, 1.3 – 1.7 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within specification, redisassemble
and readjust.
AX–106
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
7.
8.
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
STAKE COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR NUT
INSTALL DRIVE PINION CAP
9. INSTALL CARRIER COVER
(a) Clean the threads of the bolts and case with white gasoline.
(b) Coat the threads of the bolts with sealer.
Sealer:
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(c)
Install the carrier cover over the gasket.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
AX0SY–01
4–SPEED GEAR UNIT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE SHAFT
(a) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
(b) Using a socket wrench and hammer, drive in a new manual valve shaft oil seal to the case.
(c)
Assemble a new collar to the manual valve lever.
(d) Install the manual valve lever shaft to the transaxle case
through the manual valve lever.
AX–107
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(e) Using a pin punch, drive in the roll pin until its surface is
flush with the manual valve lever surface.
(f)
Match the collar hole to the lever calking hollow and calk
the collar to the lever.
(g) Install the retaining spring.
(h) Make sure that the lever moves smoothly.
2. INSTALL PARKING LOCK PAWL
(a) Place the parking lock pawl onto the case. Hook the
spring ends to the case and pawl.
(b) Install the pin into the hole of the case through the spring
and pawl.
AX–108
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
3.
INSTALL PARKING LOCK ROD
4.
INSTALL PARKING LOCK PAWL BRACKET
Torque: 7.4 N·m (75 kgf·cm, 65 in.·lbf)
5.
CHECK OPERATION OF PARKING LOCK PAWL
Make sure the counter driven gear is locked when the
manual valve lever is in the P position.
6.
INSTALL FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE PISTON TO
TRANSMISSION CASE
(a) Coat a new O–rings with ATF.
(b) Install the 2 O–rings on the piston.
(c)
Push the piston into the bore of the case, facing the spring
seat upward.
AX–109
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
7. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place the return spring and snap ring on the piston.
(b) Place SST, and compress the return spring evenly by
tightening the bolt gradually.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32040)
(c)
Install snap ring. Visually check to make sure it is fully
seated and centered by the 3 lugs on the spring retainer.
Be sure the end gap of snap ring is not aligned with the
spring retainer claw.
(d) Remove SST.
8. INSTALL OVERDRIVE UNIT
(a) Install the overdrive brake apply gasket and overdrive
clutch apply gasket.
(b) Install the overdrive brake drum to the case.
(c) Install a new case gasket to the case.
(d) Make sure that the length from the top surface of the case
to the counter driven gear top surface should be about 24
mm (0.94 in.).
AX–110
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(e) Install the overdrive unit with overdrive case to the transaxle case.
(f) Install and tighten the bolts.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
9. CHECK INTERMEDIATE SHAFT END PLAY
(a) Make sure that the intermediate shaft has thrust play.
Thrust play:
0.49 – 1.51 mm (0.0193 – 0.0594 in.)
If the thrust play is not within specification, check the
installation of intermediate shaft.
(b) Make sure that the intermediate shaft turns smoothly.
10. INSTALL FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE IN CASE
(a) Install the inner flange facing the flat end toward the oil
pump side.
(b) Install the discs and plates.
Install in order: P=Plate D=Disc
D–P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D
(c) Install the outer flange, facing the flat end toward the piston side.
11. INSTALL SNAP RING
Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of the cutouts.
12. CHECK OPERATION OF FIRST AND REVERSE
BRAKE
Apply compressed air into the oil passage with the case
and be sure that the piston moves.
AX–111
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
13. INSTALL RING GEAR INTO CASE
(a) Coat the races and bearing with petroleum jelly and install
them onto the ring gear.
Bearing and races
mm (in.)
Outer Diameter
Inner Diameter
Front Race
37.3 (1.469)
24.1 (0.949)
Bearing
37.6 (1.480)
24.0 (0.945)
Rear Race
37.6 (1.480)
22.2 (0.874)
(b) Install the ring gear into the case.
14. INSTALL REAR PLANETARY GEAR INTO CASE
(a) Align the flukes of the discs in the first and reverse brake.
(b) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly.
Align the tab of the washer with the hollow of the carrier.
(c) Align the spline of the planetary carrier with either of the
flukes of the discs, and install the planetary gear into the
first and reverse brake discs.
15. INSTALL NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH INTO CASE WITH
SHINY SIDE UPWARD
(a) Place the one–way clutch with the shiny side upward.
(b) Install the one–way clutch onto the inner race while turning the planetary gear clockwise with SST.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
AX–112
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
onto the planetary gear.
16. CHECK OPERATION OF NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Turn the planetary carrier. The carrier should turn freely
clockwise and lock counterclockwise.
17. INSTALL SNAP RING
Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of cutouts.
18. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND GUIDE
Install the 2 band guides so that its tip touches the case.
19. INSTALL SECOND BRAKE INTO CASE
(a) Install the flange, facing the flat end toward the oil pump
side.
(b) Install the discs and plates.
Install in order: P=Plate D=Disc
Flange – D – P – D – P – D – P
AX–113
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
20. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
Each spring end is installed onto the protrusion with the
case.
21. INSTALL SECOND BRAKE DRUM INTO CASE
Align the groove of the drum with the bolt and place it into
the case.
22. INSTALL SNAP RING
(a) Place the snap ring into the case so that the end gap is
installed into the groove.
(b) While compressing the piston return springs over the
drum with hammer handles, install the snap ring into the
groove.
(c) Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of the cutouts.
23. INSTALL SECOND BRAKE DRUM GASKET
Install a new gasket until it makes contact with the second
brake drum.
24. CHECK OPERATION OF SECOND BRAKE
Blow compressed air into the oil passage with the case,
and be sure that the piston moves.
AX–114
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
25. INSTALL NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND SECOND
BRAKE HUB
(a) Align the flukes of the discs in the second brake.
(b) Align the spline of the hub with the flukes of the discs and
install the hub to the second brake discs.
(c)
Check the distance between the surfaces of the second
brake hub and rear planetary gear.
Distance:
Approx. 5 mm (0.20 in.)
26. INSTALL SUN GEAR AND SUN GEAR INPUT DRUM
While turning the sun gear clockwise, install it into the
one–way clutch.
27. INSTALL FRONT PLANETARY GEAR ONTO RING
GEAR
(a) Coat the races and bearing with petroleum jelly, and
install them onto the ring gear.
Bearing and race
mm (in.)
Outer Diameter
Inner Diameter
Front Race
37.9 (1.492)
22.0 (0.866)
Bearing
36.1 (1.421)
22.2 (0.874)
Rear Bearing
35.0 (1.378)
19.0 (1.102)
AX–115
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Coat the race and bearing with petroleum jelly, and install
them onto the planetary gear.
Bearing and race
mm (in.)
Outer Diameter
Inner Diameter
Bearing
45.0 (1.772)
30.0 (1.181)
Race
45.0 (1.772)
28.0 (1.102)
(c)
Install the planetary gear onto the ring gear.
28. INSTALL FRONT PLANETARY GEAR ASSEMBLY
ONTO SUN GEAR
(a) If the planetary gear and other parts are installed correctly
into the case, the end of the bushing with the ring gear
flange will be flush with a shoulder of the intermediate
shaft or under.
(b) Coat the race with petroleum jelly and install it onto the tip
of ring gear flange.
Race:
Outer diameter
35.7 mm (1.406 in.)
Inner diameter
23.0 mm (0.906 in.)
29. INSTALL INTERMEDIATE SHAFT OIL SEAL RING
AX–116
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
30. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND
(a) Place the band into the case.
(b) Install the pin through the oil pump mounting bolt hole.
31. INSTALL FORWARD CLUTCH AND DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Coat the races and bearing with petroleum jelly, and
install them onto both sides of the clutch drum.
Bearing and race (Front side)
mm (in.)
Outer Diameter
Inner Diameter
Bearing
42.0 (1.645)
28.9 (1.138)
Race
42.0 (1.654)
27.1 (1.067)
AT2765:Bearing and race (Rear side)
mm (in.)
Outer Diameter
Inner Diameter
Bearing
36.1 (1.421)
22.2 (0.874)
Race
37.9 (1.492)
22.0 (0.866)
(b) Coat the clutch drum thrust washer with petroleum jelly
and install it with the oil groove facing upward onto the direct clutch drum.
(c)
Align the flukes of discs in the direct clutch.
AX–117
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(d) Mesh the hub with the flukes of the direct clutch while turning the clutch drum or forward clutch.
(e) If the flukes of the discs are meshed with the hub correctly,
the end of the bushing with the direct clutch drum will be
flush with the surface of the forward clutch.
(f) Place the direct clutch and forward clutch into the case.
(g) Rotate the forward clutch to mesh the front planetary ring
gear and discs.
(h) Check the distance between the A and B.
Distance:
Approx. 3 mm (0.118 in.)
32. INSTALL OIL PUMP INTO CASE
(a) Coat the race with petroleum jelly and install it onto stator
shaft.
(b) Coat a new O–ring with ATF and install it to oil pump.
AX–118
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(c)
Place the oil pump through the input shaft, and align the
bolt holes of the pump body with the transaxle case.
(d) Hold the input shaft, and lightly press the oil pump body
to slide the oil seal rings on the stator shaft through the
direct clutch drum.
NOTICE: Do not push on the oil pump strongly or the oil
seal ring will stick to the direct clutch drum.
(e) Install tighten the 7 bolts.
Torque: 22 N·m (225 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
AX–119
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
33. MEASURE THRUST PLAY OF INPUT SHAFT
Measure the thrust play with a dial gauge.
Thrust play:
0.3 – 0.9 mm (0.012 – 0.035 in.)
HINT: There are 2 thickness of races for the end of stator
shaft.
If the thrust play is in excess of standard, select one of
them.
Race thicknesses:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
1.4 mm (0.055 in.)
34. CHECK INPUT SHAFT ROTATION
Make sure that the input shaft rotates smoothly.
35. INSTALL DRIVE PINION CAP
36. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
(a) Coat a new O–rings with ATF and install them on the cover.
(b) Install the outer spring with the piston.
(c) Place the cover into the bore.
AX–120
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(d) Using SST, install the snap ring while pressing the cover.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(e) Check that the front end of the piston rod contacts the
center of the second brake band depression.
37. CHECK SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON STROKE
(a) Apply a small amount of paint to the piston rod at the point
it meets the case.
(b) Using SST, measure the piston stroke while applying and
releasing compressed air (392 – 785 kPa, 4 – 8 kgf·cm,
57 – 114 psi).
SST 09240–00020
Piston stroke:
1.5 – 3.0 mm (0.059 – 0.118 in)
If the stroke is more than standard value, replace the piston rod with a longer one.
Piston rod length:
72.9 mm (2.870 in)
71.4 mm (2.811 in)
38. INSTALL ACCUMULATOR PISTONS AND SPRINGS
(a) Install the springs and pistons into the bore.
Sprnig
Free length
mm (in.)
Color
C1
57.64 (2.2693)
Red, Purple
B2
69.39 (2.7323)
Green, White
C2
70.21 (2.7641)
Purple
(b) Place the cover with the gasket and tighten the bolts gradually in sequence.
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the illustration.
AX–121
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
39. INSTALL NEW SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
40. INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE IN CASE
Push the cable through the case, being careful not to
damage the O–ring. Check for full seating.
NOTICE: In subsequent work, to avoid breaking the cable
fitting do not roll the case over the cable.
41. INSTALL SOLENOID WIRING
42. PLACE VALVE BODY ON TRANSAXLE
(a) While holding the cam down by your hand, slip the cable
end into the slot.
(b) Lower the valve body into place.
NOTICE: Do not entangle the kick–down switch wire or solenoid wire.
43. INSTALL BOLTS IN VALVE BODY
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the illustration. Hand tighten the 12 bolts first, then torque with a
torque wrench.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
AX–122
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
44. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE BODY AND DETENT
SPRING
HINT: Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the illustration.
(a) Align the manual valve with the pin on the manual shaft
lever.
(b) Lower the manual valve body into place.
(c) Hand tighten the 4 bolts first. Then, tighten them with a
torque wrench.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(d) Place the detent spring on the manual valve body and
hand tighten the 2 bolts first.
Then, tighten them with a torque wrench.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(e) Check that the manual valve lever is touching the center
of the detent spring tip roller.
45. INSTALL OIL TUBES
Using a plastic hammer, install the 4 tubes into the positions indicated in the illustration.
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the tubes.
46. INSTALL TUBE BRACKET
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
47. INSTALL OIL STRAINER
Each bolt length (mm, in.) is indicated in the figure.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
AX–123
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
48. CONNECT SOLENOID WIRING
(a) Connect the No.1 solenoid connector. (white and shorter
wire)
(b) Connect the No.2 solenoid connector. (black and longer
wire)
49. INSTALL 3 MAGNETS IN PLACE
NOTICE: Make sure that the magnets do not interfere with
the oil tubes.
50. INSTALL OIL PAN WITH NEW GASKET
Torque: 4.9 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 43 in.·lbf)
51. INSTALL COVER
52. INSTALL COVER BRACKET
AX–124
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
53. INSTALL SOLENOID WIRING RETAINING PLATE
54. INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE RETAINING PLATE
55. INSTALL FILLER TUBE AND BRACKET
56. INSTALL SL SOLENOID
(a) Coat the O–ring with ATF and push the tip of SL solenoid
into the hole.
(b) Tighten the 2 bolts evenly and gradually.
57. INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Install the park/neutral position switch to the manual valve
shaft.
(b) Install the seal gasket and locking plate.
(c) Tighten the nut and stake it with the locking plate.
Torque: 6.9 N·m (70 kgf·cm, 61 in.·lbf)
58. ADJUST PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Align the groove and return neutral basic line.
(b) Lock the switch with 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
59.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL UNION AND ELBOW
Coat a new O–rings with ATF.
Install the O–rings to the union and elbow.
Install the union and elbow to the transaxle case.
Torque: 27 N·m (275 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
HINT: Install the elbow as shown in the illustration.
AX–125
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
60. INSTALL MANUAL SHIFT LEVER
IN–1
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
IN002–0W
To assist you in finding your way through the manual, the Section Title and major heading are given
at the top of every page.
PREPARATION
Preparation lists the SST (Special Service Tools), recommended tools, equipment, lubricant and SSM
(Special Service Materials) which should be prepared before beginning the operation and explains the
purpose of each one.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
Most repair operations begin with an overview illustration. It identifies the components and shows how
the parts fit together.
Example:
IN–2
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The
procedures are presented in a step–by–step format:
The illustration shows what to do and where to do it.
The task heading tells what to do.
The detailed text tells how to perform the task and gives other information such as specifications
and warnings.
Example:
This format provides the experienced technician with a FAST TRACK to the information needed. The
upper case task heading can be read at a glance when necessary, and the text below it provides detailed information. Important specifications and warnings always stand out in bold type.
REFERENCES
References have been kept to a minimum. However, when they are required you are given the page
to refer to.
SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications are presented in bold type throughout the text where needed. You never have to leave
the procedure to look up your specifications. They are also found at the back of AX section, for quick
reference.
IN–3
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
CAUTIONS, NOTICES, HINTS:
CAUTIONS are presented in bold type, and indicate there is a possibility of injury to you or other
people.
NOTICES are also presented in bold type, and indicate the possibility of damage to the components being repaired.
HINTS are separated from the text but do not appear in bold. They provide additional information
to help you perform the repair efficiently.
SI UNIT
The UNITS given in this manual are primarily expressed according to the SI UNIT (International System
of Unit), and alternately expressed in the metric system and in the English system.
Example:
Torque: 30 N·m (310 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
IN–4
INTRODUCTION
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
IN022–07
Use fender, seat and floor covers to keep the vehicle
clean and prevent damage.
During disassembly, keep parts in the appropriate order
to facilitate reassembly.
Observe the following:
(a) Before performing electrical work, disconnect the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(b) If it is necessary to disconnect the battery for inspection or repair, always disconnect the cable from the
negative (–) terminal which is grounded to the vehicle body.
(c) To prevent damage to the battery terminal post, loosen the terminal nut and raise the cable straight up
without twisting or prying it.
(d) Clean the battery terminal posts and cable terminals
with a clean shop rag. Do not scrape them with a file
or other abrasive objects.
(e) Install the cable terminal to the battery post with the
nut loose, and tighten the nut after installation. Do
not use a hammer to tap the terminal onto the post.
(f) Be sure the cover for the positive (+) terminal is properly in place.
Check hose and wiring connectors to make sure that they
are secure and correct.
Non–reusable parts
(a) Always replace cotter pins, gaskets, O–rings and oil
seals etc. with new ones.
(b) Non–reusable parts are indicated in the component
illustrations by the ”” symbol.
Precoated parts
Precoated parts are bolts and nuts, etc. that are coated
with a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(a) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
caused to move in any way, it must be recoated with
the specified adhesive.
(b) When reusing precoated parts, clean off the old
adhesive and dry with compressed air. Then apply
IN–5
INTRODUCTION
7.
8.
9.
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
the specified seal lock adhesive to the bolt, nut or
threads.
(c) Precoated parts are indicated in the component illustrations by the ”” symbol.
When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to prevent
leaks.
Carefully observe all specifications for bolt tightening
torques. Always use a torque wrench.
Use of special service tools (SST) and special service materials (SSM) may be required, depending on the nature
of the repair. Be sure to use SST and SSM where specified and follow the proper work procedure. A list of SST
and SSM can be found at the preparation of AX section.
10. When replacing fuses, be sure the new fuse has the correct amperage rating. DO NOT exceed the rating or use
one with a lower rating.
11. To pull apart electrical connectors, pull on the connector
itself, not the wires.
12. Care must be taken when jacking up and supporting the
vehicle. Be sure to lift and support the vehicle at the proper locations.
(a) If the vehicle is to be jacked up only at the front or
rear end, be sure to block the wheels at the opposite
end in order to ensure safety.
(b) After the vehicle is jacked up, be sure to support it on
stands. It is extremely dangerous to do any work on
a vehicle raised on a jack alone, even for a small job
that can be finished quickly.
IN–6
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
IN016–02
This glossary lists all SAE–J1930 terms and abbreviations used in this manual in compliance with SAE
recommendations, as well as their Toyota equivalents.
SAE
TOYOTA TERMS
SAE TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS
( )––ABBREVIATIONS
A/C
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
AP
Accelerator Pedal
B+
Battery Positive Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
CL
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CMP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CPP
Clutch Pedal Position
–
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
–
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
–
DFI
Direct Fuel Injection (Diesel)
DI
Distributor Ignition
DLC1
Data Link Connector 1
1: Check Connector
DLC2
Data Link Connector 2
2: Toyota Diagnosis Communication Link (TDCL)
DLC3
Data Link Connector 3
3: OBD@@@@@: [g 2] Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
ECL
Engine Control Level
ECM
Engine Control Module
Engine ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory
–
+B, Battery Voltage
–
–
Direct Injection (DI)
–
–
–
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM),
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
EI
Electronic Ignition
Toyota Distributorless Ignition (TDI)
EM
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
EPROM
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
EVAP
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
FC
Fan Control
FEEPROM
–
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable
–
Read Only Memory
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
–
FF
Flexible Fuel
–
FP
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
GEN
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
HO2S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
IN–7
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
IAC
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
IFI
Indirect Fuel Injection
IFS
Inertia Fuel–Shutoff
–
ISC
Idle Speed Control
–
KS
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
–
Indirect Injection
Manifold Pressure
Intake Vacuum
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
MC
Mixture Control
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
MFI
Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Check Engine Light
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
–
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
–
NVRAM
Non–Volatile Random Access Memory
–
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, O2 Sensor (O2S)
OBD
On–Board Diagnostic
On–Board Diagnostic (OBD)
OC
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalyst Converter (OC), CCo
OP
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
–
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
–
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
–
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
–
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
RAM
Random Access Memory
RM
Relay Module
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
SC
Supercharger
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger Bypass
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
–
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
–
SRT
System Readiness Test
–
ST
Scan Tool
–
TB
Throttle Body
TBI
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TC
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
Torque Converter
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Transmission ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
TP
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TR
Transmission Range
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
–
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
Random Access Memory (RAM)
–
–
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
Throttle Body
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
–
IN–8
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
TWC
Three–Way Catalytic Converter
TWC+OC
Three–Way + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR + CCo
VAF
Volume Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
VR
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Read Switch Type)
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU–OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
WU–TWC
Warm Up Three–Way Catalytic Converter
3GR
Third Gear
–
4GR
Fourth Gear
–
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
Three–Way Catalyst (TWC)
CCRO
–
Manifold Converter
IN–9
INTRODUCTION
–
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS
MANUAL
IN01H–0R
ATF
Automatic Transaxle Fluid
B0
Overdrive Brake
B1
Second coast Brake
B2
Second Brake
B3
First and Reverse Brake
C0
Overdrive Direct Clutch
C1
Forward Clutch
C2
Direct Clutch
D
Disc
F
Flange
F0
O/D One–way Clutch
F1
No.1 One–way Clutch
F2
No.2 One–way Clutch
MP
Multipurpose
O/D
Overdirve
P
Plate
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
IN–10
INTRODUCTION
–
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
IN008–02
IN–11
INTRODUCTION
–
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
AX–1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DESCRIPTION
DESCRIPTION
AX0CH–05
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Type of Transaxle
A541E
Type of Engine
1MZ–FE
Torque Converter Clutch Stall Torque Ratio
1.8 : 1
Torque Converter Clutch Lock–up Mechanism
Gear Ratio
Transaxle
B1 Band Width
Equipped
1st Gear
2.810
2nd Gear
1.549
3rd Gear
1.000
O/D Gear
0.735
Reverse Gear
2.296
Number of Discs and Plates
O/D Direct Clutch (C0)
2/2
Forward Clutch (C1)
5/5
Direct Clutch (C2)
3/3
2nd Brake (B2)
3/3
First and Reverse Brake (B3)
6/6
O/D Brake (B0)
3/3
mm (in.)
ATF Type
Capacity liter (US qts, Imp.qts)
25 (0.98)
ATF D–@@@@@: [g 2] or DEXRON®@@@@@: [g
3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
A/T
6.75(7.1, 5.9)
D/F
0.85 (0.9, 0.7)
AX–2
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
OPERATION
1.
MECHANICAL OPERATION
AX0RF–01
AX–3
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
AX019–03
2.
FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
AX–4
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
Power from the engine transmitted to the input shaft via the torque converter clutch is then transmitted
to the planetary gears by the operation of the clutch.
By operation of the brake and one–way clutch, either the planetary carrier or the planetary sun gear
are immobilized, altering the speed of revolution of the planetary gear unit.
Shift change is carried out by altering the combination of clutch and brake operation.
Each clutch and brake operates by hydraulic pressure; gear position is decided according to the throttle
opening angle and vehicle speed, and shift change automatically occurs.
The conditions of operation for each gear position are shown on the following illustrations:
AX–5
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
AX01A–0B
3.
HYDRAULIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The hydraulic control system is composed of the oil pump, the valve body, the solenoid valves, the accumulators, the clutches and brakes as well as the fluid passages which connect all of these components.
Based on the hydraulic pressure created by the oil pump, the hydraulic control system governs the hydraulic pressure acting on the torque converter clutch, clutches and brakes in accordance with the vehicle driving conditions.
There are three solenoid valves on the valve body.
The No.1 and No.2 solenoid vales are turned on and off by signals from the ECM to operate the shift
valves and change the gear shift position.
The SL solenoid valve is operated by signals from the ECM to engage or disengage the lock–up clutch
of the torque converter clutch.
The SLN solenoid valve is operated by signals from the ECM to control the engagement speed and
reduce gear shift shock.
AX–6
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
AX02L–06
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09226–10010
Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
09240–00020
Wire Gauge Set
09316–20011
Transfer Bearing Replacer
09316–60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316–00011)
Replacer Pipe
09350–32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
09308–10010
Oil Seal Puller
(09351–32032)
Counter Driven Gear Holding Tool
(09351–32040)
No.1 Piston Spring Compressor
(09351–32050)
Snap Ring Expander
(09351–32061)
Oil Pump Puller
(09351–32070)
No.2 Piston Spring Compressor
(09351–32080)
Lock Nut Wrench
Install RH retainer oil seal
AX–7
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
(09351–32100)
Drive Pinion Bearing Replacer
(09351–32120)
Overdrive Bearing Replacer
(09351–32140)
Oil Seal Replacer
(09351–32150)
Oil Seal Replacer
(09351–32190)
Measure Terminal
(09351–32200)
No.3 Piston Spring Compressor
09608–16011
Rear Hub Bearing Tool–
Remove differential side bearing
09612–65014
Steering Worm Bearing Puller
Remove pinion shaft bearing outer
race
09950–40010
Puller B Set
AX02M–02
RECOMMENDED COOL
09031–00030
Pin Punch .
AX–8
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
AX02N–02
EQUIPMENT
Feeler gauge
Check major clearance.
Vernier calipers
Check length of second coast
brake piston rod.
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Check piston stroke and end play
of the output shaft.
Dial indicator
Check inside diameter of
major bushing.
Straight edge
Check side clearance of oil pump.
Torque wrench
AX01V–08
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Automatic transaxle fluid:
Dry fill
Drain and refill
Classification
ATF D–@@@@@: [g 2] or
6.75 liters (7.10 US qts, 5.94 Imp.qts)
2.5 liters (2.6 US qts, 2.2 Imp.qts)
DEXRON®@@@@@: [g
3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
ATF D–@@@@@: [g 2] or
Differential oil
0.85 liters (0.89 US qts, 0.75 Imp.qts)
DEXRON®@@@@@: [g
3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
AX02P–02
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00090
Seal Packing 1281,
THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
(FIPG)
Differential LH bearing retainer
Differential RH retainer
08833–00070
Adhesive 1324,
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Differential RH retainer set bolt
AX–9
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX02Q–02
COMPONENTS
AX–10
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–11
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–12
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX0TT–02
SEPARATE BASIC SUBASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SHIFT CONTROL CABLE BRACKET
2. REMOVE UNION AND ELBOW
(a) Remove the manual shift lever.
(b) Using a open end wrench, remove the union and elbow.
(c) Remove the O–rings from the union and elbow.
3. REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Pry off the lock washer and remove the manual valve
shaft nut.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and pull out the park/neutral position
switch.
4.
REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE RETAINING BOLT AND
PLATE
AX–14
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
5. REMOVE T/M REVOLUTION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and T/M revolution sensor.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the T/M revolution sensor.
6.
REMOVE TRANSAXLE CASE UPPER COVER
7. REMOVE OIL PAN AND GASKET
(a) Remove the 17 bolts.
(b) Remove the oil pan by lifting transaxle case.
NOTICE: Do not turn the transaxle over as this will contaminate the valve body with the foreign materials in the bottom
of the oil pan.
(c)
Place the transaxle on wooden blocks to prevent damage
to the oil pipe bracket.
8.
EXHAUST PARTICLES IN PAN
Remove the magnet and use it to collect any steel chips.
Lock carefully at the chips and particles in the oil pan and
on magnet to anticipate what type of wear you will find in
the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non–magnetic): bushing wear
9.
REMOVE OIL PIPE BRACKET AND STRAINER
AX–15
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
10. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE BODY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and detent spring.
(b) Remove the 5 bolts and manual valve body with the
manual valve.
(c) Remove the manual valve from the manual valve body.
11. REMOVE OIL PIPES
(a) Remove the bolt.
(b) Pry up both pipe ends with a large screwdriver and remove the 6 pipes.
12. DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
13. REMOVE CONNECTOR CLAMP AND PIPE RETAINER
AX–16
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
14. REMOVE B3 APPLY PIPE
Pry up the pipe with a screwdriver and remove the pipe.
15. REMOVE VALVE BODY
(a) Remove the 9 bolts.
(b) Remove the wire harness clamp.
(c)
Disconnect the throttle cable from the cam, and remove
the valve body.
16. REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE
AX–17
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
17. REMOVE SOLENOID WIRING
Remove the bolt and the solenoid wiring.
18. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
19. REMOVE ACCUMULATOR PISTONS AND SPRINGS
(a) Loosen the 4 bolts one turn at a time until the spring tension is released.
(b) Remove the cover and gasket.
(c) Remove the C1 accumulator piston and spring.
(d) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
(e) Pop out pistons for C2 and B2 into a rag, using low–pressure compressed air (98 kPa, 1 kgf/cm2, 14 psi).
(f) Remove the O–rings from the pistons.
AX–18
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
20. MEASURE PISTON STROKE SECOND COAST
BRAKE
(a) Apply a small amount of paint to the piston rod at the point
it meets the case.
(b) Using SST, measure the piston stroke while applying and
releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8 kgf/cm2,
57–114 psi).
SST 09240–00020
Maximum thrust clearance:
2.0–3.5 mm (0.079–0.138 in.)
If the piston stroke exceeds the limit, inspect the second
coast brake band.
21. REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
(a) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014
(b) Applying compressed air to the oil hole, remove the second coast brake cover, piston assembly and spring.
(c) Remove the 2 O–rings from the cover.
AX–19
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
22. STAND TRANSAXLE ENGINE SIDE UPWARD
23. REMOVE OIL PUMP
NOTICE: Before removing the oil pump, remove the second coast brake piston.
(a) Remove the 7 bolts.
(b) Using SST, pull out the oil pump from the transaxle case.
SST 09350–32014
24. REMOVE O–RING FROM OIL PUMP
25. REMOVE DIRECT CLUTCH AND FORWARD CLUTCH
26. SEPARATE DIRECT CLUTCH AND FORWARD
CLUTCH
(a) Separate the direct clutch and forward clutch.
(b) Remove the thrust washer from direct clutch.
AX–20
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
27. REMOVE BEARING FROM FORWARD CLUTCH
28. REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND
(a) Push the pin with a small screwdriver and remove it from
the bolt hole of the oil pump mounting.
(b) Remove the brake band.
29. REMOVE FRONT PLANETARY RING GEAR
30. REMOVE FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Remove the front planetary gear.
(b) Remove the 2 bearings from the planetary gear.
AX–21
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
31. REMOVE SUN GEAR AND SUN GEAR INPUT DRUM
(a) Remove the sun gear and the sun gear input drum.
(b) Remove the thrust washer from sun gear input drum.
32. CHECK OPERATION OF SECOND BRAKE PISTON
Apply compressed air into the case passage and confirm
that the piston moves.
If the piston does not move, disassembe and inspect.
33. REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND GUIDE
34. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE DRUM
(a) Remove the snap ring.
AX–22
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Remove the second brake drum.
35. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE PISTON RETURN SPRING
36. REMOVE NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
37. REMOVE PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
38. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE DRUM GASKET
Remove the gasket.
AX–23
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
39. REMOVE NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND REAR PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the No.2 one–way clutch and rear planetary
gear.
(c)
Remove the thrust washer from the rear planetary gear.
40. REMOVE REAR PLANETARY RING GEAR
(a) Remove the rear planetary ring gear.
(b) Remove the bearing from the ring gear.
41. CHECK FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
(a) Check the operation of the first and reverse brake piston.
Apply compressed air into the case passage and confirm
that the piston moves.
If the piston does not move, disassemble and inspect.
AX–24
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Using a filler gauge, check the pack clearance of the first
and reverse brake.
Clearance: 1.92–2.68 mm (0.0756–0.1055 in.)
42. REMOVE FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES OF FIRST
AND REVERSE BRAKE
(a) Remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the flange, 6 discs and plates.
43. TURN TRANSAXLE CASE AROUND
44. REMOVE OVERDRIVE UNIT
(a) Remove the 13 bolts.
(b) Tap on the circumference of the overdrive case with a
plastic hammer to remove the overdrive case and gasket.
AX–25
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
Remove the overdrive planetary gear from transaxle
case.
(d) Remove the overdrive brake drum from the transaxle
case.
(e) Remove the overdrive clutch apply gasket and overdrive
brake apply gasket.
45. REMOVE FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE PISTON
(a) Remove the piston return spring.
Place SST, compress the return spring evenly by
tightening the bolt gradually.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32040)
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Remove the SST.
Remove the return spring from the case.
AX–26
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Apply compressed air into the passage of the case to remove the piston.
HINT: Hold the piston so it is not slanted and blow with the
gun slightly away from the oil hole.
(c)
If the piston does not pop out with compressed air, use
needle–nose pliers to remove it.
(d) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
(e) Remove the snap ring.
46. REMOVE PARKING LOCK PAWL BRACKET AND
GUIDE
AX–27
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
47. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE SHAFT
(a) Using a chisel and hammer, cut the collar.
(b) Remove the retaining spring.
(c)
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the pin.
(d) Slide out the shaft from the transaxle case and remove
the manual valve lever and parking lock rod.
48. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE SHAFT OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal.
AX–28
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
49. REMOVE PIN, SPRING AND PARKING LOCK PAWL
AX02S–04
DIFFERENTIAL COMPONENT PARTS
REMOVAL
1.
MEASURE DIFFERENTIAL TOTAL PRELOAD
Using a small torque wrench, measure the total preload
and make a note of it.
2. REMOVE LH BEARING RETAINER
(a) Remove the 6 bolts.
(b) Using a large screwdriver, remove the LH bearing retainer.
NOTICE: Wrap the screwdriver tip in a rag, etc. to avoid
damaging the case and retainer.
3. REMOVE RH RETAINER
(a) Remove the 5 bolts.
AX–29
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Using a large screwdriver, remove the RH retainer.
NOTICE: Wrap the screwdriver tip in a rag, etc. to avoid
damaging the case and retainer.
4. REMOVE CARRIER COVER
(a) Remove the 10 bolts.
(b) Tap the carrier cover with a plastic hammer to remove it.
(c)
Remove the apply gasket.
5.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Remove the differential case, outer case and shim from
the transaxle case.
AX–30
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
6. REMOVE TRANSAXLE CAP
(a) Remove the bolt.
(b) Using pliers, pull out the drive pinion cap.
(c) Remove the O–rings from the cap.
7.
MEASURE DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
Using a small torque wrench, measure the drive pinion
preload.
Preload (Reused bearing at starting):
0.5–0.8 N·m (5–8 kgf·cm, 4.3–6.9 in.·lbf)
The total preload measured in step 1 minus the drive pinion preload equals 0.1–0.2 N·m (1.3–2.0 kgf·cm, 1.1–1.7
in.·lbf). If the result is not within this specification, the side
bearing preload is suspect.
8. REMOVE COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR
(a) Using a chisel and hammer, loosen the staked part of the
nut.
(b) Using SST to hold the gear, remove the nut.
SST 09330–00021, 09350–32014 (09351–32032)
AX–31
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
Using SST, remove the gear and bearing.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32061)
9. REMOVE OUTER RACE, SPACER AND OIL SLINGER
(a) Using SST, remove the outer race with oil slinger and
spacer.
SST 09350–32014 (09308–10010)
(b) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
10. REMOVE DRIVE PINION
(a) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(b) Install the bar into the case hole to drive out the drive pinion.
(c) Using a press, drive out the drive pinion from transaxle
case.
AX–32
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(d) Remove the bearing cage from drive pinion.
(e) Using SST, press out the bearing.
SST 09950–00020
AX–33
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX02T–07
GENERAL NOTES
The instructions here are organized so that you work on only one component group at a time.
This will help avoid confusion from similar–looking parts of different subassemblies being on your workbench at the same time.
The component groups are inspected and repaired from the converter housing side.
As much as possible, complete the inspection, repair and assembly before proceeding to the next component group. If a component group cannot be assembled because parts are being ordered, be sure to keep
all parts of that group in a separate container while proceeding with disassembly, inspection, repair and
assembly of other component groups.
Recommended fluid for the automatic transaxle: ATF D–@@@@@: [g 2] or DEXRON®@@@@@: [g
3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
1. GENERAL CLEANING NOTES:
(a) All disassembled parts should be washed clean and any fluid passages and holes blown through with
compressed air.
(b) When using compressed air to dry parts, always aim away from yourself to prevent accidentally spraying automatic transaxle fluid or kerosene in your face.
(c) The recommended automatic transaxle fluid or kerosene should be used for cleaning.
2. PARTS ARRANGEMENT:
(a) After cleaning, the parts should be arranged in the correct order to allow efficient inspection, repairs,
and reassembly.
(b) When disassembling a valve body, be sure to keep each valve together with the corresponding spring.
(c) New brakes and clutches that are to be used for replacement must be soaked in transaxle fluid for at
least fifteen minutes before assembly.
3. GENERAL ASSEMBLY:
(a) All oil seal rings, clutch discs, clutch plates, rotating parts, and sliding surfaces should be coated with
transmission fluid prior to reassembly.
(b) All gaskets and rubber O–rings should be replaced.
(c) Make sure that the ends of a snap ring are not aligned with one of the cutouts and are installed in the
groove correctly.
(d) If a worn bushing is to be replaced, the subassembly containing that bushing must be replaced.
(e) Check thrust bearings and races for wear or damage. Replace if necessary.
(f) Use petroleum jelly to keep parts in place.
AX–34
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
SECOND COAST BRAKE
AX02U–02
COMPONENTS
SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
DISASSEMBLY
1.
AX02V–02
REMOVE OIL SEAL RING
Remove the oil seal ring from the piston.
2. REMOVE PISTON ROD
(a) Remove the E–ring while pushing the piston with needle–
nose pliers.
AX–35
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
(b) Remove the inner spring, plate washer and piston rod.
AX02W–03
SECOND COAST BRAKE COMPONENT
INSPECTION
If the lining of the brake band is peeling off or discolored,
or even part of the printed mark is defaced, replace the
brake band.
AX02X–03
SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
ASSEMBLY
1.
SELECT PISTON ROD
If the band is OK but piston stroke not within the standard
value, select a new piston rod.
Piston stroke:
2.0–3.5 mm (0.079–0.138 in.)
There are 2 lengths of piston rod.
Piston rod length:
95.2 mm (3.748 in.)
96.3 mm (3.791 in.)
2. INSTALL PISTON ROD
(a) Install the plate washer and inner spring to the piston rod.
AX–36
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
(b) Install the E–ring while pushing the piston.
3. INSTALL OIL SEAL RING
(a) Apply ATF to the oil seal ring.
(b) Install the oil seal ring to the piston.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends more than necessary.
AX–37
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OIL PUMP
OIL PUMP
AX02Y–02
COMPONENTS
OIL PUMP DISASSEMBLY
AX02Z–02
1.
REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
Remove the 2 oil seal rings from the stator shaft back
side.
2.
REMOVE THRUST WASHER FROM STATOR SHAFT
BACK SIDE
AX–38
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OIL PUMP
3.
REMOVE STATOR SHAFT
Remove the 11 bolts and stator shaft.
HINT: Keep the gears in assembly order.
4.
REMOVE FRONT OIL SEAL
Pry off the oil seal with a screwdriver.
AX030–06
OIL PUMP BUSHING INSPECTION
1.
CHECK BODY CLEARANCE OF DRIVEN GEAR
Push the driven gear to one side of the body.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard body clearance:
0.07–0.15 mm (0.0028–0.0059 in.)
Maximum body clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
2.
CHECK TIP CLEARANCE OF DRIVEN GEAR
Measure between the driven gear teeth and the crescent–shaped part of the pump body.
Standard tip clearance:
0.11–0.14 mm (0.0043–0.0055 in.)
Maximum tip clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than the maximum, replace
the oil pump body subassembly.
AX–39
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
3.
–
OIL PUMP
CHECK SIDE CLEARANCE OF BOTH GEARS
Using a steel straightedge and feeler gauge, measure the
side clearance of both gears.
Standard side clearance:
0.002–0.005 mm (0.0008–0.0020 in.)
Maximum side clearance:
0.100 mm (0.0039 in.)
There are 3 different thicknesses for drive and driven
gears.
Drive and driven gear thickness
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
A
9.440–9.456 (0.3717–0.3723)
B
9.456–9.474 (0.3723–0.3730)
C
9.474–9.490 (0.3730–0.3736)
If the thickest gear can not make the side clearance within
standard specification, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
4.
CHECK OIL PUMP BODY BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
oil pump body bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
38.18 mm (1.5031 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
5.
CHECK STATOR SHAFT BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter stator
shaft bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
21.57 mm (0.8492 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the stator shaft.
AX031–02
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal. The seal
end should be flush with the outer edge of the pump body.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32140)
AX–40
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
–
OIL PUMP
INSTALL DRIVEN GEAR AND DRIVE GEAR
Make sure the top of the gears are facing upward.
3. INSTALL STATOR SHAFT TO PUMP BODY
(a) Align the stator shaft with each bolt hole.
(b) Torque the 11 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
4. INSTALL THRUST WASHER
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly.
(b) Align the tab of the washer with the hollow of the pump
body.
5.
INSTALL OIL SEAL RINGS
Install the 2 oil seal rings to the stator shaft back side.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends more than necessary.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
6.
CHECK PUMP DRIVE GEAR ROTATION
Turn the drive gear with 2 screwdrivers and make sure it
rotates smoothly.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
AX–41
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
DIRECT CLUTCH
AX032–02
COMPONENTS
DIRECT CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
AX033–05
1. CHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Install the direct clutch on the oil pump.
(b) Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the direct clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8
kg/cm2, 57–114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
0.91–1.35 mm (0.0358–0.0531 in.)
If the piston stroke is greater than the maximum, inspect
each component.
AX–42
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
3.
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
REMOVE SNAP RING FROM CLUTCH DRUM
REMOVE FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
4. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the
springs with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(b) Remove the snap ring with snap ring pliers.
(c)
Remove the piston return spring.
5. REMOVE CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Install the direct clutch onto the oil pump.
(b) Apply compressed air to the oil pump to remove the piston
(if the piston does not come out completely, use needle–
nose pliers to remove it).
(c) Remove the direct clutch from the oil pump.
(d) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX–43
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
AX034–03
DIRECT CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying low–pressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
3.
CHECK DIRECT CLUTCH BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
direct clutch bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
48.27 mm (1.9004 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the direct clutch.
DIRECT CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
AX035–06
1. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON IN DIRECT CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install new O–rings to the piston. Coat the O–rings with
ATF.
(b) Being careful not to damage the O–rings, press the piston
into the drum with the cup side up.
2. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place the return spring and snap ring onto the piston.
AX–44
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
(b) Place SST on the spring retainer, and compress the return spring with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(c) Install the snap ring using snap ring pliers. Be sure the
end gap of snap ring is aligned with the spring retainer
claw.
3. INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
(a) Install plates and discs.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–P–D
(b) Install the flange with the flat end facing downward.
4.
INSTALL SNAP RING
Check that the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of the cutouts.
5. RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Install the direct clutch on the oil pump.
(b) Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the direct clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8
kgf/cm2, 57–114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
0.91–1.35 mm (0.0358–0.0531 in.)
If the piston stroke is non–standard, select another
flange.
HINT: There are 2 different thickness for the flange.
Flange thickness:
2.70 mm (0.1063 in.)
3.00 mm (0.1181 in.)
AX–45
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
FORWARD CLUTCH
AX036–02
COMPONENTS
FORWARD CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
1.
AX037–04
CHECK PISTON STROKE OF FORWARD CLUTCH
Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the forward clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8
kgf/cm2, 57–114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
1.79–2.21 mm (0.0704–0.0870 in.)
each component.
AX–46
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
2.
REMOVE SNAP RING FROM CLUTCH DRUM
3.
REMOVE FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
4. REMOVE RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the
springs with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(b) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(c)
Remove the return spring.
5. REMOVE CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Apply compressed air into the oil passage to remove the
piston.
If the piston does not come out, use needle–nose pliers
to remove it.
AX–47
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
6.
IF NECESSARY, REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
Remove the 3 oil seal rings from the shaft.
AX038–03
FORWARD CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying low–pressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX039–04
FORWARD CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OIL SEAL RINGS
Install the 3 oil seal rings to the shaft.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends more than necessary.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
AX–48
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
2. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON TO CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install the 2 new O–rings to the piston.
(b) Coat the O–ring with ATF.
(c) Press the piston into the drum with the cup side up, being
careful not to damage the O–rings.
3. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRINGS
(a) Place the return spring and snap ring onto the piston.
(b) Place SST on the spring retainer, and compress the
springs with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(c) Install the snap ring with snap ring pliers.
Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
the spring retainer claw.
4. INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
(a) Install the plates and discs.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D
(b) Install the flange with the flat end facing downward.
5.
INSTALL SNAP RING
Check that the end gap of snap ring is not aligned with one
of the cutouts.
AX–49
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
6.
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF FORWARD CLUTCH
Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the forward clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8
kgf/cm2, 57–114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
1.79–2.21 mm (0.0704–0.0870 in.)
If the piston stroke is non–standard, select another
flange.
HINT: There are 2 different thicknesses for the flange.
Flange thickness:
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
2.70 mm (1.0630 in.)
AX–50
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
AX03A–02
COMPONENTS
AX0TU–03
NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND SUN GEAR
DISASSEMBLY
1.
CHECK OPERATION OF NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Hold the sun gear and turn the hub. The hub should turn
freely clockwise and should lock counterclockwise.
2.
REMOVE NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH FROM SUN GEAR
While turning the hub clockwise, remove the No.1 one–
way clutch from the sun gear.
AX–51
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
3. REMOVE SUN GEAR FROM DRUM
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring from the
drum.
(b) Remove the sun gear from the drum.
4.
CHECK SUN GEAR BUSHINGS
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
sun gear bushings.
Maximum inside diameter:
22.59 mm (0.8894 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the sun gear.
AX0TV–01
NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND SUN GEAR
ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL SUN GEAR TO DRUM
(a) Install the sun gear to the drum.
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring to drum.
2.
3.
INSTALL NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH ON SUN GEAR
While turning the hub clockwise, slide the No.1 one–way
clutch onto the sun gear.
RECHECK OPERATION OF NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
AX03D–02
PLANETARY RING GEAR INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT RING GEAR FLANGE BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
flange bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
30.08 mm (1.1842 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the flange.
AX–52
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
2. REMOVE RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the flange from the ring gear.
3. INSTALL RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Position the flange into the ring gear.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR INSPECTION
AX03E–03
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.16–0.56 mm (0.0063–0.0220 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.61 mm (0.0240 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
AX–53
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND BRAKE
SECOND BRAKE
AX03F–02
COMPONENTS
AX03G–03
SECOND BRAKE PISTON DISASSEMBLY
REMOVE SECOND BRAKE PISTON
(a) Apply compressed air to the oil hole to remove the piston.
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX–54
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND BRAKE
AX03H–03
SECOND BRAKE COMPONENT INSPECTION
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX03J–06
SECOND BRAKE PISTON ASSEMBLY
INSTALL PISTON
(a) Coat a new O–ring with ATF.
(b) Install the 2 new O–rings on the piston.
(c)
Press the piston into the drum, being careful not to damage the O–rings.
AX–55
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
AX03K–02
COMPONENTS
NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
AX03L–02
1.
CHECK OPERATION OF NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Hold the outer race and turn the rear planetary gear. The
rear planetary gear should turn freely counterclockwise
and should lock clockwise.
2.
SEPARATE NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND REAR
PLANETARY GEAR
REMOVE THRUST WASHER
Remove the thrust washer from the rear side of planetary
gear.
3.
AX–56
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
4.
REMOVE NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH FROM OUTER
RACE
(a) Remove the 2 snap rings and retainers from both sides.
(b) Remove the No.2 one–way clutch from the outer race.
AX03M–03
REAR PLANETARY GEAR INSPECTION
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.16–0.56 mm (0.0063–0.0220 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.61 mm (0.0240 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
AX03N–02
1. INSTALL ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install the No.2 one–way clutch into the outer race, facing
the flange side of the No.2 one–way clutch toward the
shiny side of the outer race.
(b) Install the 2 retainers and snap rings to both sides.
AX–57
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
2.
INSTALL PLANETARY GEAR INTO NO.2 ONE–WAY
CLUTCH
Install the planetary gear into the No.2 one–way clutch,
facing the inner race of the rear planetary gear toward the
black side of the No.2 one–way clutch outer race.
3.
CHECK OPERATION OF NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
4. INSTALL THRUST WASHER
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly.
(b) Align the tab of the washer with the hollows of the carrier.
RING GEAR FLANGE REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the flange from the ring gear.
2. INSTALL RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Position the flange into the ring gear.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
AX03P–02
AX–58
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
AX03Q–02
COMPONENTS
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
COMPONENTS INSPECTION
AX03R–03
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGES
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flanges are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX–59
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX03S–02
COMPONENTS
AX–60
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX03T–03
OVERDRIVE BRAKE DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) While pushing the return spring, remove the snap ring
with a screwdriver.
(b) Remove the piston return spring.
2.
REMOVE PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
3.
REMOVE PISTON FROM DRUM
Apply compressed air to oil hole to remove the piston.
HINT: Blow with the gun slightly away from the oil hole,
and be careful that the piston does not tilt.
4.
REMOVE O–RINGS
Remove the inner and outer O–rings from the piston.
AX–61
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX03U–03
OVERDRIVE BRAKE INSPECTION
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX03V–05
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
DISASSEMBLY
1.
CHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 5–8 kgf/cm2,
57–114 psi).
Piston stroke:
1.75–2.49 mm (0.0689–0.0980 in.)
2.
3.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
If the piston stroke is greater than the maximum, inspect
each component.
REMOVE OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH FROM CASE
REMOVE BEARING AND RACE FROM CLUTCH
DRUM AND CASE
AX–62
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
4.
REMOVE SNAP RING WITH SCREWDRIVER
5.
REMOVE FLANGES, DISCS AND PLATES
6. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the spring
with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070, 09351–32200)
(b) Remove the snap ring.
(c)
Remove the piston return spring.
7. REMOVE PISTON FROM CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install the clutch drum on the case.
(b) Apply compressed air to the pressure apply hole of the
case.
(c) Remove the piston from the clutch drum.
If the piston does not come out completely, use needle–
nose pliers to remove it.
(d) Remove the clutch drum from the case.
AX–63
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
8.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
REMOVE O–RINGS
Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX03W–03
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying low–pressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGES
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flanges are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
3.
CHECK DIRECT CLUTCH BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
2 direct clutch bushings.
Maximum inside diameter:
22.13 mm (0.8713 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the direct clutch drum.
AX03X–06
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Install new O–rings to the piston. Coat the O–rings with
ATF.
AX–64
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
(b) Press the piston into the drum with the cup side up, being
careful not to damage the O–ring.
2. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Install the return spring and seat snap ring in place.
(b) Place SST on the spring retainer, and compress the
spring with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070, 09351–32200)
(c) Install the snap ring with a screwdriver. Be sure end gap
of snap ring is aligned with the groove of the clutch drum.
3.
INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–Flange
4.
INSTALL SNAP RING
Be sure end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the
groove of the clutch drum.
AX–65
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
5. INSTALL BEARING AND RACE
(a) Coat the bearing with petroleum jelly and install it facing
the race side downward to the clutch drum.
Bearing outer diameter: 46.3 mm (1.823 in.)
Bearing inner diameter: 26.2 mm (1.031 in.)
(b) Coat the race with petroleum jelly and install it to the case.
Race outer diameter: 43.0 mm (1.693 in.)
Race inner diameter: 24.5 mm (0.965 in.)
6.
INSTALL DIRECT CLUTCH ON CASE
7.
RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8 kgf/cm2,
57–114 psi).
Piston stroke:
1.75–2.49 mm (0.0689–0.0980 in.)
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
AX03Y–03
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR DISASSEMBLY
1. CHECK OPERATION OF ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install the O/D direct clutch into the one–way clutch.
(b) Hold the O/D direct clutch and turn the intermediate shaft.
The shaft should turn freely clockwise and should lock
counterclockwise.
(c) Remove the O/D direct clutch.
AX–66
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
2. CHECK COUNTER DRIVE GEAR PRELOAD
(a) Hold the O/D planetary gear in a vise with soft jaws.
HINT: Do not let the counter drive gear touch the vise.
(b) Using a tension gauge, measure the preload.
Preload (at starting):
9.2–15.3 N (940–1,560 g, 2.1–3.4 lb)
HINT: Turn the counter drive gear right and left several
times before measuring the preload.
3. REMOVE O/D ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND OUTER RACE
(a) Remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the retaining plate.
(c) Remove the O/D one–way clutch with outer race.
(d) Remove the 2 retainers from both sides of the O/D one–
way clutch.
AX–67
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
(e) Remove the O/D one–way clutch from the outer race.
HINT: Note the direction of the one–way clutch.
4.
5.
REMOVE NO.3 PLANETARY THRUST WASHER
REMOVE PLUGS FROM PLANETARY GEAR
Remove the 4 plugs with a magnetic finger.
NOTICE: Be careful not to lose them.
6. REMOVE ADJUSTING NUT AND LOCKING WASHER
(a) Pry off the locking washer.
(b) Using SST, loosen the adjusting nut.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32080)
(c) Remove the adjusting nut and locking washer.
7.
REMOVE INTERMEDIATE SHAFT BEARING
Using SST, press out the bearing from the shaft.
SST 09950–00020
AX–68
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
8.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
REMOVE COUNTER DRIVE GEAR AND FRONT
BEARING
Press out the gear and bearing together.
9. REMOVE REAR BEARING
(a) Using SST, press out the bearing.
SST 09950–00020
(b) Tag the bearings to show the location for reassembly.
10. REMOVE O/D PLANETARY RING GEAR FROM
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) While pulling up the ring gear, compress the snap ring
with needle–nose pliers and remove it from the groove.
(b) Remove the ring gear from the counter drive gear.
(c)
Remove the snap ring from the ring gear.
AX–69
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
11. REMOVE OUTER RACES FROM COUNTER DRIVE
GEAR
(a) Drive out the 2 races with a brass bar and hammer.
(b) Tag the races to show the location for reassembly.
12. REMOVE SNAP RING FROM COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
OVERDRIVE PLANETARY GEAR
INSPECTION
AX03Z–03
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.16–0.56 mm (0.0063–0.0220 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.61 mm (0.0240 in.)
If the clearance is greater then the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
AX–70
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX040–03
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL SNAP RING INTO COUNTER GEAR
Install the snap ring with a screwdriver.
2.
INSTALL OUTER RACES INTO COUNTER DRIVE
GEAR
Using SST, press in the 2 outer races to both sides of the
gear.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120, 09351–32150)
HINT: Press in the 2 outer races until they touch the snap
ring. Tap the races in straight, so that they do not tilt.
3.
INSTALL OVERDRIVE PLANETARY RING GEAR INTO
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) Install the snap ring to the ring gear.
(b) While pushing down the ring gear, squeeze the snap ring
end with needle–nose pliers, and install it into the groove.
4.
INSTALL REAR BEARING
Using SST, press in the bearing onto the shaft.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
HINT: Press in the bearing until the side surface of the inner race touches the planetary carrier.
AX–71
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
5.
INSTALL COUNTER DRIVE GEAR AND FRONT BEARING
(a) Install the gear onto the shaft, and mesh the ring gear with
the planetary pinions.
(b) Place the front bearing on to the shaft.
(c)
Using SST, press in the bearing until there is slight play
between the bearings.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
HINT: Hold the ring gear to prevent it from falling.
6.
INSTALL INTERMEDIATE SHAFT BEARING
Using SST, press in the bearing until it slightly touches the
front bearing of the counter drive gear.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
HINT: The counter drive gear can be turned lightly.
7.
PLACE NEW LOCKING WASHER
8.
INSTALL ADJUSTING NUT AND ADJUST PRELOAD
OF COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) Hold the overdrive planetary gear in a vise with soft jaws.
(b) Using SST, tighten the adjusting nut until the following
gear starting load is reached on the tension gauge.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32080)
Preload (at starting):
9.2–15.3 N (940–1,560 g, 2.1–3.4 lb)
AX–72
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
HINT: Turn the counter drive gear right and left several
times before measuring the preload.
Lock the adjusting nut with one locking washer tab. Bend
the locking washer tab until it is flat with the adjusting nut
groove.
9.
INSTALL NO.3 OVERDRIVE PLANETARY THRUST
WASHER
10. INSTALL PINION SHAFT PLUGS
Install the 4 plugs into the pinion shaft.
11. INSTALL OVERDRIVE ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND RETAINING PLATE
(a) Install the one–way clutch into the outer race.
(b) Install the 2 retainers on both sides of the one–way clutch.
(c)
Install the one–way clutch into the overdrive planetary
gear.
HINT: Be sure that the one–way clutch is installed in the
correct direction.
(d) Install the retaining plate.
AX–73
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
(e) Install the snap ring.
12. CHECK OPERATION OF O/D ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install the overdrive direct clutch into the one–way clutch.
(b) Hold the overdrive direct clutch and turn the intermediate
shaft. The shaft should turn freely clockwise and should
lock counterclockwise.
(c) Remove the overdrive direct clutch.
AX041–02
OVERDRIVE CASE DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE C0 ACCUMULATOR PISTON FROM OVERDRIVE CASE
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the retaining plate and 2 springs.
(c) Remove the accumulator piston.
(d) Remove the O–ring from the piston.
AX–74
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
AX042–02
OVERDRIVE CASE ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OIL SEAL RINGS ON OVERDRIVE CASE
Install the 2 oil seal rings to the overdrive case groove,
then snug them down by squeezing their ends together.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
2.
INSTALL C0 ACCUMULATOR PISTON TO OVERDRIVE CASE
(a) Install a new O–ring to the accumulator piston.
(b) Coat the O–ring with ATF.
(c)
Install the accumulator piston, 2 springs and retaining
plate.
(d) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
AX–75
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX043–05
OVERDRIVE BRAKE ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL PISTON INTO DRUM
(a) Install new O–rings to the piston.
Coat the new O–rings with ATF.
(b) Press the piston into the drum, being careful not to damage the O–rings.
2.
INSTALL FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
Install the flange, discs and plates.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
Flange–D–P–D–P–D–P
3.
POSITION PISTON RETURN SPRING
AX–76
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
4.
INSTALL SNAP RING INTO CASE
Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of cutouts.
5.
INSTALL OVERDRIVE PLANETARY GEAR ONTO OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
While turning the overdrive planetary gear clockwise,
install it onto the overdrive direct clutch.
HINT: If the overdrive planetary gear is properly installed
onto the direct clutch, the counter drive gear height from
the overdrive case will be about 24 mm (0.94 in.).
AX–77
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
VALVE BODY
AX044–02
COMPONENTS
VALVE BODY DISASSEMBLY
AX0TW–01
NOTICE: When disassembling the valve body, be careful
not to damage or deform the plate which overhangs the
valve body.
1. REMOVE SOLENOIDS
(a) Remove No.1 and No.2 solenoids with the retainer.
NOTICE: When removing the solenoid, do not use a screwdriver, etc. to pry up the solenoid.
(b) Remove the O–ring from each solenoid.
(c) Remove the No.3 solenoid.
(d) Remove the O–ring from the solenoid.
AX–78
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
–
VALVE BODY
REMOVE LOCK PLATE
3. REMOVE B0 ACCUMULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts.
(b) Remove the B0 accumulator assembly.
4. DISASSEMBLE B0 ACCUMULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Applying compressed air to the cylinder hole, remove the
piston and spring.
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
5. REMOVE NO.4 SOLENOID
(a) Remove the No.4 solenoid.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the solenoid.
6.
REMOVE NO.1 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER
Remove the 5 bolts and No.1 lower valve body cover.
AX–79
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
7.
REMOVE OIL STRAINER, NO.1 LOWER VALVE BODY
COVER GASKETS AND CHECK VALVE
(a) Remove the 2 gaskets and plate from the lower valve
body.
(b) Remove the oil strainer, check valve and spring.
8.
REMOVE PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
9.
REMOVE NO.2 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER, OIL
STRAINER, CHECK BALLS AND VIBRATING STOPPER
Remove the 11 bolts and lower valve body cover.
(b) Remove the 2 check balls, oil strainer and vibrating stopper.
AX–80
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
10. REMOVE NO.2 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER GASKETS AND CHECK BALLS
(a) Remove the 2 screws from the lower valve body cover.
(b) Remove the 2 gaskets and plate.
(c)
Remove the 3 check balls from the cover.
11. REMOVE BOLTS FROM UPPER VALVE BODY
Remove the 3 bolts.
12. LIFT OFF UPPER VALVE BODY AND NO.1 PLATE AS
A SINGLE UNIT
Hold No.1 plate to the upper valve body and lift off the upper valve body.
HINT: Be careful that the check balls and oil strainer do
not fall out.
AX–81
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
13. REMOVE 2 CHECK BALLS AND VIBRATING STOPPER FROM UPPER VALVE BODY
14. REMOVE 2 OIL STRAINERS AND CHECK BALL FROM
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX0TX–01
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL 2 CHECK BALLS AND VIBRATING STOPPER TO UPPER VALVE BODY
2.
INSTALL 2 OIL STRAINERS AND CHECK BALL TO
LOWER VALVE BODY
3.
POSITION PLATE AND NEW GASKETS ON UPPER
VALVE BODY
Position new No.1 gasket, plate and the new No.2 gasket
on the upper valve body.
HINT: Since No.1 gasket and No.2 gasket are similar, use
the illustration below to discriminate between them.
AX–82
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
4.
PLACE UPPER VALVE BODY WITH PLATE AND GASKETS ON LOWER VALVE BODY
Hold the upper valve body, plate and gaskets securely so
they do not separate.
Align each bolt hole in the valve bodies with the gaskets
and plate.
5.
INSTALL AND FINGER TIGHTEN BOLTS IN UPPER
VALVE BODY TO SECURE LOWER VALVE BODY
Install and finger tighten the 3 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 44 mm (1.732 in.)
Bolt B: 16 mm (0.630 in.)
6.
INSTALL NO.2 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER GASKETS, PLATE AND 3 CHECK BALLS
(a) Install the 3 check balls into the No.2 lower valve body
cover.
AX–83
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
(b) Position a new gasket and plate and then another new
gasket.
HINT: Both gaskets are identical.
(c)
Install the 2 screws.
8. INSTALL NO.2 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER
(a) Position the No.2 lower valve body cover.
(b) Install and finger tighten the 11 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 40 mm (1.575 in.)
Bolt B: 44 mm (1.732 in.)
Bolt C: 14 mm (0.551in.)
9.
INSTALL OIL STRAINER AND CHECK VALVE
Install the oil strainer and check valve into the lower valve
body.
AX–84
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
10. INSTALL LOWER VALVE BODY COVER GASKETS
AND NO.2 PLATE
Position a new gasket and plate and then another new
gasket.
HINT: Both gaskets are identical.
11. INSTALL LOWER VALVE BODY COVER
(a) Position the lower valve body cover.
(b) Install and finger tighten the 5 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length
Bolt A: 47 mm (1.850 in.)
Bolt B: 14 mm (0.551 in.)
12. INSTALL PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
13. TIGHTEN BOLTS OF UPPER AND LOWER VALVE BODIES
(a) Tighten the 16 bolts in the lower valve body.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
(b) Tighten the 3 bolts in the upper valve body.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
14. INSTALL B0 ACCUMULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Coat new O–rings with ATF and install them to the piston.
(b) Install the spring and piston into the cylinder.
Spring dimensions
mm (in.)
Color
Free length
Coil outer diameter
Inner
White
47.5 (1.870)
18.9 (0.744)
Outer
None
16.3 (0.642)
20.7 (0.815)
AX–85
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
(d) Install the B0 accumulator assembly.
(e) Install the torque the 3 bolts.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
15. INSTALL LOCK PLATE
16. INSTALL SOLENOIDS
(a) Coat new O–rings with ATF and install them to the solenoids.
(b) Install the lock–up solenoid.
(c) Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
(d) Install the No.4 solenoid.
(e) Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
(d) Install No.1 and No.2 solenoids.
(e) Install and torque the 3 bolts.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
AX–86
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX047–03
COMPONENTS
AX–87
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX048–03
VALVE BODY SPRINGS SPECIFICATIONS
HINT: During reassembly please refer to the spring specifications above to help discriminate between
the different springs.
Mar
k
Name (Color)
Free Length / Outer Diameter
mm (in.)
Total No. of Coils
@@
@@
@:
Lock–Up Relay Valve (Yellow)
26.8 (1.055) / 10.2 (0.402)
10.8
B1 Orifice Control Valve (White)
24.8 (0.976) / 6.4 (0.252)
12.0
Throttle Valve (Green)
31.5 (1.240) / 7.0 (0.276)
11.4
Down–Shift Plug (None)
15.0 (0.591) / 11.0 (0.433)
7.0
[c A]
@@
@@
@:
[c B]
@@
@@
@:
[c C]
@@
@@
@:
[c D]
AX–88
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
@@
@@
@:
[c E]
Low Coast Modulator Valve (Purple)
20.2 (0.795) / 7.9 (0.311)
11.9
AX–89
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX0GZ–02
RETAINERS, PIN, AND CHECK BALLS LOCATION
1.
PIN, RETAINERS
Mark
Name
Height / Width / Thickness
mm (in.)
@@@@@: [c A]
B1 Orifice Control Valve
8.9 (0.350) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c B]
Low Coast Modulator Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
2.
CHECK BALLS
AX–90
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX04A–03
COMPONENTS
AX–91
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX04B–03
VALVE BODY SPRINGS SPECIFICATIONS
HINT: During reassembly please refer to the spring specifications above to help discriminate between
the different springs.
Mar
k
Name (Color)
Free Length / Outer Diameter
mm (in.)
Total No. of Coils
@@
@@
@:
Accumulator Control Valve (Red)
25.1 (0.988) / 8.6 (0.339)
8.0
2–3 Shift Valve (None)
28.0 (1.102) / 7.6 (0.299)
10.3
1–2 Shift Valve (Light Green)
29.2 (1.150) / 8.9 (0.350)
12.0
Reverse Control Valve (White/Purple)
38.1 (1.500) / 6.5 (0.256)
19.0
[c A]
@@
@@
@:
[c B]
@@
@@
@:
[c C]
@@
@@
@:
[c D]
AX–92
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
@@
@@
@:
Cut–Back Valve (None)
21.8 (0.858) / 6.0 (0.236)
13.5
Primary Regulator Valve (None)
36.6 (1.441) / 16.1 (0.634)
6.3
3–4 Shift Valve (None)
28.0 (1.102) / 7.6 (0.299)
10.3
Second Lock Valve (None)
20.7 (0.815) / 7.4 (0.291)
9.5
Second Coast Modulator Valve (White)
32.2 (1.268) / 9.0 (0.354)
11.4
Solenoid Modulator Valve (Purple/Pink)
30.2 (1.189) / 5.6 (0.220)
15.3
Secondary Regulator Valve (None)
46.9 (1.846) / 5.9 (0.232)
21.8
[c E]
@@
@@
@:
[c F]
@@
@@
@:
[c G]
@@
@@
@:
[c H]
@@
@@
@:
[c I]
@@
@@
@:
[c J]
@@
@@
@:
[c K]
AX–93
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX0TY–01
RETAINERS AND CHECK BALLS LOCATION
1.
RETAINERS
Mark
Name
Height / Width / Thickness mm (in.)
@@@@@: [c A]
Accumulator Control Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c B]
2–3 Shift Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c C]
1–2 Shift Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c D]
Reverse Control Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c E]
Cut–Back Valve
6.5 (0.256) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c F]
Secondary Regulator Valve
11.0 (0.433) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c G]
Solenoid Modulator Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c H]
Lock–Up Control Valve
9.2 (0.362) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c I]
Second Coast Modulator Valve
8.0 (0.315) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c J]
Second Lock Valve
9.2 (0.362) / 11.5 (0.453) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c K]
3–4 Shift Valve
6.5 (0.256) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
2.
CHECK BALLS
Upper Side
AX–94
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Lower Side
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX–95
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
AX04D–02
COMPONENTS
AX–96
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
AX0TZ–02
DIFFERENTIAL CASE DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SIDE BEARING
Using SST, remove the 2 side bearings.
SST 09608–16011, 09550–40010
2. REMOVE RING GEAR
(a) Place matchmarks on both the differential case and ring
gear.
(b) Remove the 12 bolts.
(c)
Using a plastic hammer, tap out the ring gear.
3.
CHECK SIDE GEAR BACKLASH
Using a dial gauge, measure the backlash of each side
gear while holding one pinion toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
AX–97
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
4. DISASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Drive out the pinion shaft lock pin from the side on which
the ring gear is installed.
(b) Remove the pinion shaft from the case.
(c) Remove the 2 pinions and side gears with the 4 thrust
washers.
AX0U0–02
DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
1. ASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Install the removed thrust washers to the side gears.
(b) Install the side gears with thrust washers, pinion thrust
washers and pinion gears.
(c)
Install the pinion shaft.
AX–98
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
(d) Check the side gear backlash.
Measure the side gear backlash while holding one pinion
gear toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05–0.20 mm (0.0020–0.0079 in.)
Refering to the table below, select thrust washers which
will ensure that the backlash is within specification. Try to
select washers of the same size for both sides.
Thrust washer thickness
mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.60 (0.0630)
1.70 (0.0670)
1.80 (0.0709)
If the backlash is not within specification, install a thrust
washer of a different thickness.
(e) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive the lock pin through
the case and hole in the pinion shaft.
(f) Stake the differential case.
2. INSTALL RING GEAR
(a) Clean the contact surface of the differential case.
(b) Heat the ring gear to about 100°C (212°F) in an oil bath.
NOTICE: Do not heat the ring gear above 110°C (230°F).
(c) Carefully remove the ring gear from the oil bath.
(d) Clean the contact surface of the ring gear with cleaning
solvent.
(e) Quickly install the ring gear on the differential case.
Install the 12 bolts.
HINT: Align the matchmarks on the differential left case
and contact the ring gear.
(f) Tighten the set bolts uniformly a little at a time.
Torque the bolts.
Torque: 124 N·m (1,260 kgf·cm, 91 ft·lbf)
AX–99
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
3. INSTALL SIDE BEARING
(a) Install the speedometer drive gear onto the differential
case.
(b) Using SST and a press, press in the RH side bearing onto
the differential case.
SST 09316–20011
(c)
Using SST and a press, press in the LH side bearing onto
the differential case.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00010)
AX–100
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
AX04G–06
Disassembly, inspection and assembly of each component group have been indicated in the preceding
chapter. Before assembly, make sure, again, that all component groups are assembled correctly.
If something wrong is found in a certain component group during assembly, inspect and repair this group
immediately.
Recommended ATF: D–@@@@@: [g 2] or DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
AX04H–03
GENERAL INSTALLATION NOTES:
(a) The automatic transaxle is composed of highly precision–finished parts, necessitating careful inspection before assembly because even a small nick could cause fluid leakage or affect performance.
(b) Before assembling new clutch discs, soak them in automatic transaxle fluid for at least 15 minutes.
(c) Apply automatic transaxle fluid on the sliding or rotating surfaces of parts before assembly.
(d) Use petroleum jelly to keep small parts in their places.
(e) Do not use adhesive cements on gaskets and similar parts.
(f) When assembling the transaxle, be sure to use new gaskets and O–rings.
(g) Dry all parts with compressed air–never use shop rags.
(h) Be sure to install the thrust bearings and races in the correct direction and position.
AX–101
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Mark
Thrust Bearing Outside Diameter
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
Thrust Bearing Inside Diameter
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
A
See page AX–118
27.7 (1.091)
B
47.6 (1.874)
31.4 (1.236)
C
45.5 (1.791)
30.1 (1.185)
D
45.5 (1.791)
30.1 (1.185)
E
38.7 (1.524)
22.6 (0.890)
F
46.3 (1.823)
28.6 (1.126)
AX–102
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
AX0U1–02
DIFFERENTIAL AND DRIVE PINION
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL DRIVE PINION INTO TRANSAXLE CASE
(a) Using SST, install the bearing to the drive pinion shaft.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
(b) Place the bearing cage onto the drive pinion shaft.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seals with the
pinion shaft.
(c)
Using a brass bar and hammer, slightly tap the bearing
cage into the transaxle case until the snap ring groove in
the bore can be seen.
(d) Using SST, install snap ring into the bore.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(e) Using SST, install the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
AX–103
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
2.
PLACE OIL SLINGER AND NEW SPACER
HINT: Install the spacer with the small end downward.
3.
INSTALL OUTER RACE TO TRANSAXLE CASE
Using SST, press in the outer race.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32100, 09351–32140)
4. INSTALL COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) Place a brass bar into the transaxle hole to hold the drive
pinion shaft.
(b) Using SST, press in the counter driven gear until the
counter driven gaer bearing almost touches the counter
gear.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32140)
5.
INSTALL NEW LOCK NUT AND ADJUST DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Install the new lock nut.
(b) Using SST to hold the gear, tighten the nut.
Torque: 280 N·m (2,855 kgf·cm, 206 ft·lbf)
SST 09330–00021, 09350–32014 (09351–32032)
Turn the gear counterclockwise and clockwise several
times.
(d) Using a small torque wrench, measure the preload of the
drive pinion.
(c)
Drive pinion preload (at starting):
New bearing
1.0–1.6 N·m (10–16 kgf·cm, 8.7–13.9 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing
0.5–0.8 N·m (5–8 kgf·cm, 4.3–6.9 in.·lbf)
If the preload is greater than specified, replace the
bearing spacer.
AX–104
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
If the preload is less then specified, retighten the nut
13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf) at a time until the specified preload is reached.
If the maximum torque is exceeded while retightening the
nut, replace the bearing spacer and repeat the preload
procedure.
Do not back off the nut to reduce the preload.
Maximum torque: 353 N·m (3,600 kgf·cm, 260 ft·lbf)
(e) If the preload is adjusted within specification, make a note
of it.
(f) Stroke the lock nut.
6.
INSTALL APPLY GASKET
7.
PLACE OUTER RACE AND SHIM ONTO RH SIDE
BEARING
8.
PLACE DIFFERENTIAL CASE INTO TRANSAXLE
CASE
Be sure to install the shim and outer race into place.
AX–105
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
9. INSTALL CARRIER COVER
(a) Remove any packing material and be careful not to drop
oil on the contacting surfaces of the carrier cover and
transaxle case.
(b) Apply seal packing to the carrier cover.
Seal packing:
Part No.08826–00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
(c)
HINT: Install the carrier cover within 10 minutes after applying seal packing.
Install and torque the 11 bolts.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 100 mm (3.937 in.)
Bolt B: 65 mm (2.559 in.)
Bolt C: 75 mm (2.953 in.)
10. ADJUST SIDE BEARING PRELOAD
(a) Remove any packing material on the contacting surfaces
of the LH bearing retainer and transaxle case.
HINT: Do not apply seal packing yet.
(b) Install the LH bearing retainer and torque the 6 bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(c)
Snap down the bearings by turning the differential case
several times.
(d) Using a small torque wrench, measure the differential total preload.
Total preload (at starting):
New bearing
Drive pinion preload plus 0.2–0.4 N·m
(2.5–5.1 kgf·cm, 2.2–3.6 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing
Drive pinion preload plus 0.1–0.2 N·m
(1.3–2.0 kgf·cm, 1.1–1.7 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within specification, replace the adjusting shim in the LH bearing retainer with one of a different thickness.
AX–106
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
AT3700:Adjusting shim thickness
mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness
Mark
Thickness
0
2.00 (0.0787)
9
2.45 (0.0965)
1
2.05 (0.0807)
A
2.50 (0.0984)
2
2.10 (0.0827)
B
2.55 (0.1004)
3
2.15 (0.0846)
C
2.60 (0.1024)
4
2.20 (0.0866)
D
2.65 (0.1043)
5
2.25 (0.0886)
E
2.70 (0.1063)
6
2.30 (0.0906)
F
2.75 (0.1083)
7
2.35 (0.0925)
G
2.80 (0.1102)
8
2.40 (0.0945)
H
2.85 (0.1122)
11. INSTALL LH BEARING RETAINER
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and LH bearing retainer.
(b) Remove any FIPG material on the contacting surfaces of
LH bearing retainer, transaxle case and carrier cover.
(c) Apply FIPG to the transaxle case and carrier cover.
FIPG: Part No.08826–00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
HINT: Install the LH bearing retainer within 10 minutes after applying FIPG.
(d) Install the LH bearing retainer.
(e) Coat the threads of bolts with sealer.
Sealer: Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(f)
Tighten the bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(g) Snap down the bearings.
(h) Recheck the differential total preload.
AX–107
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
12. INSTALL NEW OIL SEAL
(a) Place the oil baffle onto the LH bearing retainer.
(b) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal unit its end is flush with
surface of the LH bearing retainer.
SST 09223–15010
13. INSTALL RH RETAINER
(a) Remove any FIPG material on the contacting surfaces of
RH retainer and transaxle case.
(b) Apply FIPG to the RH retainer.
FIPG: Part No.08826–00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
HINT: Install the RH retainer within 10 minutes after applying FIPG.
(c)
Coat the bolts’ threads with sealer.
Sealer: Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(d) Tighten the bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(e) Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09226–10010
AX–108
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
14. INSTALL DRIVE PINION CAP
(a) Install a new O–ring to the cap.
(b) Install the drive pinion cap to the transaxle case.
AX0U2–03
4–SPEED GEAR UNIT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL PARKING LOCK PAWL
(a) Place the parking lock pawl onto the case.
Hook the spring ends to the case and pawl.
(b) Instal the pin into the hole of the case through the spring
and pawl.
2. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE SHAFT
(a) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
(b) Install the manual valve shaft oil seal to the case.
(c)
Assembly a new collar to the manual valve lever.
(d) Install the manual valve shaft to the transmission case
through the manual lever.
(e) Install the parking lock rod.
AX–109
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(f)
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
Using a pin punch, drive in the roll pin until its surface is
flush with the manual valve lever surface.
(g) Match the collar hole to the lever caulking hollow and
caulk the collar to the lever.
(h) Install the retaining spring.
3.
INSTALL PARKING LOCK PAWL BRACKET AND
GUIDE
Torque: 7.4 N·m (75 kgf·cm, 65 in.·lbf)
4.
CHECK OPERATION OF PARKING LOCK PAWL
Make sure the counter driven gear is locked when the
manual valve lever is in the P position.
AX–110
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
5.
INSTALL FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE PISTON TO
TRANSMISSION CASE
(a) Coat the new O–rings with ATF.
(b) Install the 2 O–rings on the piston.
(c)
Push the piston into the bore of the case, facing the spring
seat upward.
6. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place the return spring and snap ring on the piston.
(b) Place SST, and compress the return spring evenly by
tightening the bolt gradually.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32040)
(c)
Install snap ring. Visually check to make sure it is fully
seated and centered by the 3 lugs on the spring retainer.
Be sure the end gap of snap ring is not aligned with the
spring retainer claw.
(d) Remove the SST.
7.
INSTALL SNAP RING TO TRANSAXLE CASE
AX–111
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
8. INSTALL OVERDRIVE UNIT
(a) Install the overdrive brake apply gasket and overdrive
clutch apply gasket.
(b) Install the overdrive brake drum to the case.
(c) Install the new case gasket to the case.
(d) Make sure that the length from the top surface of the case
to the counter driven gear surface should be about 24 mm
(0.94 in.).
(e) Place the new gasket onto the transaxle case.
(f) Install the overdrive assembly with overdrive case to the
transaxle case.
AX–112
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(g) Coat the threads of 23 mm (0.91 in.) bolts with sealer.
Sealer:
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(h) Install and tighten the 13 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 61 mm (2.402 in.)
Bolt B 38 mm (1.496 in.)
Bolt C: 23 mm (0.906 in.)
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
9. CHECK INTERMEDIATE SHAFT END PLAY
(a) Make sure that the intermediate shaft as end play in axial
direction.
End play: 0.47–1.50 mm (0.0185–0.0591 in.)
If the end play is not within specification, check the installation of intermediate shaft.
(b) Make sure that the intermediate shaft turns smoothly.
10. INSTALL REAR PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Install the rear planetary ring gear.
(b) Place the bearing onto the ring gear.
Bearing outer diameter: 38.7 mm (1.524 in.)
Bearing inner diameter: 22.6 mm (0.890 in.)
(c)
Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and place it
onto the rear planetary gear.
AX–113
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(d) Install the rear planetary gear.
11. INSTALL DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE OF FIRST
AND REVERSE BRAKE
(a) Install the 6 plates and discs.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D
(b) Install the flange, facing the flat end downward.
(c)
Install the snap ring.
HINT: Be sure that the end gap of the snap ring is not
aligned with one of the cutouts.
12. CHECK FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
(a) Check the operation of the first and reverse brake piston.
Apply compressed air into the case passage and confirm
that the piston moves.
(b) Using a filler gauge, check that pack clearance of the first
and reverse brake.
Clearance:
1.92–2.68 mm (0.0756–0.1055 in.)
AX–114
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
13. INSTALL NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH INTO CASE
(a) Place the No.2 one–way clutch with the shiny side of
flange upward.
(b) Install the one–way clutch while turning the planetary
gear clockwise with SST.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
If the planetary gear cannot turn clockwise, check the
installation of the one–way clutch.
(c)
Install the snap ring.
HINT: Be sure that the end gap of the snap ring is not
aligned with one of cutouts.
(d) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
onto the rear planetary gear.
14. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND GUIDE
15. PLACE NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
on the No.1 one–way clutch.
AX–115
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Place the No.1 one–way clutch onto the rear planetary
gear.
16. INSTALL SECOND BRAKE
(a) Install the flange, facing the flat end upward.
(b) Install the 3 discs and plates.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
D–P–D–P–D–P
(c)
Place the piston return spring into the case.
(d) Place the second brake drum into the case.
HINT: Align the groove of the drum with the bolt.
(e) Place the snap ring into the case so that end gap is
installed into the groove.
(f) While compressing the piston return spring over the drum
with screwdriver, install the snap ring into the groove.
(g) Be sure that the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned
with one of cutouts.
AX–116
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
17. INSTALL NEW SECOND BRAKE GASKET
Install a new gasket until it makes contact with the second
brake drum.
18. CHECK OPERATION OF SECOND BRAKE
Apply compressed air into the second brake gasket and
confirm that the piston moves.
19. INSTALL SUN GEAR AND SUN GEAR INPUT DRUM
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
on the sun gear input drum.
(b) While turning the sun gear clockwise, install it into the
No.1 one–way clutch.
20. INSTALL OIL SEAL RING TO INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
HINT: After installing the oil seal ring, check that it moves
smoothly.
AX–117
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
21. INSTALL FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Coat the bearings with petroleum jelly, and install them
onto the both sides of planetary gear.
Bearing outer diameter: 45.5 mm (1.791 in.)
Bearing inner diameter: 30.1 mm (1.185 in.)
(b) Install the planetary gear onto the sun gear.
22. INSTALL FRONT PLANETARY RING GEAR
23. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND
(a) Place the band into the case.
(b) Install the pin through the oil pump mounting bolt hole.
24. INSTALL FORWARD CLUTCH AND DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Coat the bearing with petroleum jelly and install it onto
rear side of the forward clutch.
Bearing outer diameter: 47.6 mm (1.874 in.)
Bearing inner diameter: 31.4 mm (1.236 in.)
AX–118
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Coat the bearing with petroleum jelly and install it onto the
front side of the forward clutch.
HINT: There are 2 different thickness bearings for adjustment of the input shaft thrust play.
Bearing thickness
mm (in.)
(c)
Thickness
Outer diameter
Inner diameter
3.60 (0.1417)
45.9 (1.807)
27.7 (1.091)
4.19 (0.1650)
47.1 (1.854)
27.7 (1.091)
Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
with the oil groove facing upward onto the direct clutch
drum.
(d) Mesh the hub of the forward clutch flukes with the direct
clutch discs.
HINT: Be careful that the bearing and thrust washer do not
get out of place.
(e) Install the direct clutch and forward clutch into the case.
HINT: Hold the direct clutch toward the forward clutch to
prevent the thrust washer from getting out of place.
25. INSTALL OIL PUMP INTO CASE
(a) Coat a new O–ring with ATF and install it to the oil pump.
AX–119
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Place the oil pump through the input shaft, and align the
bolt holes of the pump body with the transmission case.
NOTICE: Do not push on the oil pump strongly or the oil
seal ring will stick to the direct clutch drum.
Torque: 22 N·m (225 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
26. MEASURE END PLAY OF INPUT SHAFT
Measure the end play with a dial gauge.
End play:
0.25–0.90 mm (0.0098–0.0354 in.)
HINT: There are 2 different thickness bearings for end of
stator shaft. If the end play is in excess of standard, select
one of them.
Bearing thickness:
3.60 mm (0.1417 in.)
4.19 mm (0.1650 in.)
27. CHECK INPUT SHAFT ROTATION
Make sure that the input shaft rotates smoothly.
28. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
(a) Coat the new O–rings with ATF and install it to the cover.
(b) Install the outer spring with the piston.
(c) Place the cover into the bore.
(d) Using SST, install the snap ring while pressing the cover.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(e) Check that the front end of the piston rod contacts the
center of the second brake band depression.
29. CHECK SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON STROKE
(a) Apply a small amount of paint to the piston rod at the point
it meets the case.
AX–120
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Using SST, measure the piston stroke while applying and
releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8 kgf/cm2,
57–114 psi).
SST 09240–00020
Piston stroke:
2.0–3.5 mm (0.079–0.138 in.)
If the stroke is more than specified, replace the piston rod
with a longer one.
Piston rod length:
95.2 mm (3.748 in.)
96.3 mm (3.791 in.)
If the still more than standard value, replace the brake
band with a new one.
AX0U3–02
HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL ACCUMULATOR PISTONS AND SPRINGS
(a) Install the new O–rings to the pistons.
(b) Install the springs and pistons into the bores.
Spring dimensions
mm (in.)
Spring
Color
Free length
C2
Yellow/Purple
51.8 (2.039)
B2
None
88.2 (3.473)
B2
None
70.3 (2.767)
C1
None
73.6 (2.898)
(c)
Place the cover with a new gasket and gradually tighten
the bolts a little at a time in sequence.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
AX–121
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
2.
PLACE NEW SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
3.
INSTALL SOLENOID WIRE
4.
INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE
5. INSTALL VALVE BODY TO TRANSAXLE CASE
(a) While holding the cam down with your hand, slip the cable
end into the slot.
(b) Lower the valve body into place.
NOTICE: Do not entangle the solenoid wire.
AX–122
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
Install and tighten the 9 bolts.
HINT:
Each bolt length is indicated below.
Hand tighten the 9 bolts first, then torque with a
torque wrench.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 30 mm (1.181 in.)
Bolt B: 43 mm (1.693 in.)
Bolt C: 48 mm (1.890 in.)
Bolt D: 52 mm (2.047 in.)
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
6.
INSTALL B3 APPLY PIPE
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the pipe.
7.
INSTALL CONNECTOR CLAMP AND PIPE RETAINER
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 48 mm (1.890 in.)
Bolt B: 39 mm (1.535 in.)
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
8.
CONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
AX–123
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
9.
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
INSTALL OIL PIPES
Using a plastic hammer, install the pipes into the positions.
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the pipes.
10. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE BODY AND DETENT
SPRING
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 22 mm (0.866 in.)
Bolt B: 37 mm (1.457 in.)
(a) Align the manual valve with the pin on the manual shaft
lever.
(b) Lower the manual valve body into place.
(c) Hand tighten the 5 bolts first. Then, tighten them with a
torque wrench.
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
(d) Place the detent springs on the manual valve body and
hand tighten the 2 bolts first.
Then, tighten them with a torque wrench.
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 14 mm (0.551 in.)
Bolt B: 37 mm (1.457 in.)
(e) Check that the manual valve lever is touching the center
of the detent spring tip roller.
11. INSTALL PIPE BRACKET AND OIL STRAINER
Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 22 mm (0.866 in.)
Bolt B: 53 mm (2.087 in.)
Torque:
Pipe bracket: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Oil strainer: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
AX–124
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
12. INSTALL MAGNETS IN PLACE
NOTICE: Make sure that the magnets do not interfere with
the oil pipes.
13. INSTALL OIL PAN WITH NEW GASKET
(a) Install a new gasket and oil pan.
(b) Install and torque the 17 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 43 in.·lbf)
14. INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE RETAINING PLATE
15. INSTALL TRANSAXLE UPPER COVER
16. INSTALL T/M REVOLUTION SENSOR
(a) Install a new O–ring to the T/M revolution sensor.
(b) Install the T/M revolution sensor with the bolt.
AX–125
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
17. INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Install the park/neutral position switch to the manual valve
shaft.
(b) Place the new locking plate and tighten the nut.
(c) Stake the nut with locking plate.
(d) Install the 2 bolts.
(e) Adjust the park/neutral position switch.
HINT: Align the groove and neutral basic line.
(f) Tighten the 2 bolts.
18. INSTALL UNION AND ELBOW
(a) Install the new O–rings to the union and elbow.
(b) Install the union elbow to the transaxle case.
Torque: 27 N·m (275 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
HINT: Install the elbow, as shown in the illustration.
19. INSTALL MANUAL SHAFT LEVER
AX–126
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
20. INSTALL SHIFT CONTROL CABLE BRACKET
AX–127
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
AX0H1–06
SERVICE DATE
Second Coast Brake
2.0 – 3.5 mm
Piston stroke
0.079 – 0.138 in.
95.2 mm
Piston rod length
3.748 in.
96.3 mm
3.791 in.
Oil Pump
Body clearance
STD
Maximum
Tip clearance
STD
Maximum
Side clearance
STD
Maximum
Pump body bushing inside diameter
Maximum
0.07 – 0.15 mm
0.0028 – 0.0059 in.
0.30 mm
0.0118 in.
0.11 – 0.14 mm
0.0043 – 0.0055 in.
0.30 mm
0.0118 in.
0.02 – 0.05 mm
0.0008 – 0.0020 in.
0.10 mm
0.0039 in.
38.18 mm
1.5031 in.
Stator shaft bushing inside diameter
Front side
Maximum
Rear side
Maximum
21.57 mm
0.8492 in.
27.07 mm
1.0657 in.
Direct Clutch
Piston stroke
Drum bushing inside diameter
0.91 – 1.35 mm
0.0358 – 0.0531 in.
48.27 mm
1.9004 in.
2.70 mm
Flange thickness
0.1063 in.
3.00 mm
0.1181 in.
Forward Clutch
Piston stroke
1.79 – 2.21 mm
0.0704 – 0.0870 in.
2.30 mm
Flange thickness
0.0906 in.
2.70 mm
0.1063 in.
AX–128
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Front Planetary Gear
Sun gear bushing inside diameter
Maximum
Ring gear flange bushing inside diameter
Maximum
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
Maximum
22.59 mm
0.8894 in.
30.08 mm
1.1842 in.
0.61 mm
0.024 in.
Rear Planetary Gear
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
Maximum
0.61 mm
0.024 in.
First and Reverse Brake
1.92 – 2.68 mm
Pack clearance
0.0756 – 0.1055 in.
Overdrive Unit
1.75 – 2.49 mm
Piston stroke
Direct clutch bushing inside diameter
0.0689 – 0.0980 in.
Maximum
22.13 mm
0.8713 in.
0.16 – 0.56 mm
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
STD 0.0063 – 0.0220 in.
Maximum
0.61 mm
0.024 in.
AX–129
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Valve Body Spring
Free length / Coil outer diameter
Spring
Total No. of coils / Color
mm (in.)
Upper valve body
Low coast modulator valve
20.2 (0.795) / 7.9 (0.311)
11.9 / Purple
B1 orifice control valve
24.8 (0.976) / 6.4 (0.252)
12.0 / White
Down–shift plug
15.0 (0.591) / 11.0 (0.433)
7.0 / None
Throttle valve
31.5 (1.240) / 7.0 (0.276)
11.4 / Green
Lock–up relay valve
26.8 (1.055) / 10.2 (0.402)
10.8 / Yellow
2–3 shift valve
28.0 (1.102) / 9.4 (0.370)
10.3 / None
Second coast modulator valve
20.2 (0.795) / 7.9 (0.311)
11.9 / Purple
Lower valve body
Accumulator control vavle
25.1 (0.988) / 8.6 (0.339)
8.0 / Red
Secondary regulator valve
46.9 (1.846) / 5.9 (0.232)
21.8 / None
Second lock valve
20.7 (0.815) / 7.4 (0.291)
9.5 / None
Reverse control valve
38.1 (1.500) / 6.5 (0.256)
19.0 / White/Purple
1–2 shift valve
29.2 (1.150) / 8.9 (0.350)
12.0 / Light Green
3–4 shift valve
28.0 (1.102) / 7.6 (0.299)
10.3 / None
Primary regulator valve
36.6 (1.441) / 16.1 (0.634)
6.3 / None
Cut–back valve
21.8 (0.858) / 6.0 (0.236)
13.5 / None
Solenoid modulator valve
30.2 (1.189) / 5.6 (0.220)
15.3 / Purple/Pink
Valve Body Key
Height
Width
Thickness
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
B1 orifice control valve
8.9 (0.350)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Low coast modulator valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Accumulator control valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Secondary regulator valve
11.0 (0.433)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
1–2 shift valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
2–3 shift valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
3–4 shift valve
6.5 (0.256)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Key
Upper valve body
Lower valve body
Second lock valve
9.2 (0.362)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Second coast modulator valve
8.0 (0.315)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Reverse control valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Cut–back valve
9.2 (0.362)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Solenoid modulator valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Lock–up control valve
9.2 (0.315)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
AX–130
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Accumulator Spring
Spring
C0
Free length mm (in.)
Color
Inner
47.5 (1.870)
White
Outer
16.3 (0.642)
None
C1
73.6 (2.898)
None
C2
51.8 (2.039)
Yellow / Purple
B0
66.8 (2.630)
Red / Yellow
Inner
70.3 (2.767)
None
Outer
88.2 (3.473)
None
B2
Differential Assembly
Drive pinion preload (at Starting)
New bearing
Reused bearing
1.0 – 1.6 N·m
10 – 16 kgf·cm
8.7 – 13.9 in.·lbf
0.5 – 0.8 N·m
5 – 8 kgf·cm
4.3 – 6.9 in.·lbf
Total preload (at starting)
New bearing
Reused bearing
Pinion to side gear backlash
Drive pinion preload plus 0.3 – 0.4 N·m
2.8 – 4.4 kgf·cm 2.4 – 3.8 in.·lbf
Drive pinion preload plus 0.1 – 0.2 N·m
1.4 – 2.2 kgf·cm 1.2 – 1.9 in.·lbf
0.05 – 0.20 mm
0.0020 – 0.0079 in.
1.60 mm
Side gear thrust washer thickness
0.0630 in.
1.70 mm
0.0670 in.
1.80 mm
0.0709 in.
AX–131
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
2.00 mm
0.0787 in.
2.05 mm
0.0807 in.
2.10 mm
0.0827 in.
2.15 mm
0.0846 in.
Side bearing adjusting shim thickness
Mark
2.20 mm
0 0.0866 in.
1
2.25 mm
2 0.0886 in.
3
2.30 mm
4 0.0906 in.
5
2.35 mm
6 0.0925 in.
7
2.40 mm
8 0.0945 in.
9
2.45 mm
A 0.0965 in.
B
2.50 mm
C 0.0984 in.
D
2.55 mm
E 0.1004 in.
2.60 mm
F
G 0.1024 in.
2.65 mm
H
0.1043 in.
2.70 mm
0.1063 in.
2.75 mm
0.1083 in.
2.80 mm
0.1102 in.
2.85 mm
0.1122 in.
AX–132
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
AX04N–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Oil cooler pipe union
27
275
20
Oil pan
4.9
50
43 in.·lbf
Valve body x Transaxle case
11
110
8
Accumulator x Cover
10
100
7
Oil pump x Transaxle case
22
225
16
O/D case x Transaxle case
25
250
18
Differential LH side bearing retainer
19
195
14
Differential RH retainer
19
195
14
Differential carrier cover
39
400
29
Oil pump body x Stator shaft
10
100
7
Ring gear x Differential case
124
1,260
91
Upper valve body x Lower valve body
6.6
67
58 in.·lbf
Accumulator cylinder x Valve body
6.6
67
58 in.·lbf
Solenoid x Valve body
6.6
67
58 in.·lbf
Counter drive gear lock nut
280
2,855
206
Carrire cover x Transaxle case
39
400
29
Parking lock pawl bracket
7.4
75
65 in.·lbf
Oil strainer x Transaxle case
11
110
8
IN–1
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
IN002–0W
To assist you in finding your way through the manual, the Section Title and major heading are given
at the top of every page.
PREPARATION
Preparation lists the SST (Special Service Tools), recommended tools, equipment, lubricant and SSM
(Special Service Materials) which should be prepared before beginning the operation and explains the
purpose of each one.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
Most repair operations begin with an overview illustration. It identifies the components and shows how
the parts fit together.
Example:
IN–2
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The
procedures are presented in a step–by–step format:
The illustration shows what to do and where to do it.
The task heading tells what to do.
The detailed text tells how to perform the task and gives other information such as specifications
and warnings.
Example:
This format provides the experienced technician with a FAST TRACK to the information needed. The
upper case task heading can be read at a glance when necessary, and the text below it provides detailed information. Important specifications and warnings always stand out in bold type.
REFERENCES
References have been kept to a minimum. However, when they are required you are given the page
to refer to.
SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications are presented in bold type throughout the text where needed. You never have to leave
the procedure to look up your specifications. They are also found at the back of AX section, for quick
reference.
IN–3
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
CAUTIONS, NOTICES, HINTS:
CAUTIONS are presented in bold type, and indicate there is a possibility of injury to you or other
people.
NOTICES are also presented in bold type, and indicate the possibility of damage to the components being repaired.
HINTS are separated from the text but do not appear in bold. They provide additional information
to help you perform the repair efficiently.
SI UNIT
The UNITS given in this manual are primarily expressed according to the SI UNIT (International System
of Unit), and alternately expressed in the metric system and in the English system.
Example:
Torque: 30 N·m (310 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
IN–4
INTRODUCTION
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
IN022–07
Use fender, seat and floor covers to keep the vehicle
clean and prevent damage.
During disassembly, keep parts in the appropriate order
to facilitate reassembly.
Observe the following:
(a) Before performing electrical work, disconnect the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(b) If it is necessary to disconnect the battery for inspection or repair, always disconnect the cable from the
negative (–) terminal which is grounded to the vehicle body.
(c) To prevent damage to the battery terminal post, loosen the terminal nut and raise the cable straight up
without twisting or prying it.
(d) Clean the battery terminal posts and cable terminals
with a clean shop rag. Do not scrape them with a file
or other abrasive objects.
(e) Install the cable terminal to the battery post with the
nut loose, and tighten the nut after installation. Do
not use a hammer to tap the terminal onto the post.
(f) Be sure the cover for the positive (+) terminal is properly in place.
Check hose and wiring connectors to make sure that they
are secure and correct.
Non–reusable parts
(a) Always replace cotter pins, gaskets, O–rings and oil
seals etc. with new ones.
(b) Non–reusable parts are indicated in the component
illustrations by the ”” symbol.
Precoated parts
Precoated parts are bolts and nuts, etc. that are coated
with a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(a) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
caused to move in any way, it must be recoated with
the specified adhesive.
(b) When reusing precoated parts, clean off the old
adhesive and dry with compressed air. Then apply
IN–5
INTRODUCTION
7.
8.
9.
–
GENERAL REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
the specified seal lock adhesive to the bolt, nut or
threads.
(c) Precoated parts are indicated in the component illustrations by the ”” symbol.
When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to prevent
leaks.
Carefully observe all specifications for bolt tightening
torques. Always use a torque wrench.
Use of special service tools (SST) and special service materials (SSM) may be required, depending on the nature
of the repair. Be sure to use SST and SSM where specified and follow the proper work procedure. A list of SST
and SSM can be found at the preparation of AX section.
10. When replacing fuses, be sure the new fuse has the correct amperage rating. DO NOT exceed the rating or use
one with a lower rating.
11. To pull apart electrical connectors, pull on the connector
itself, not the wires.
12. Care must be taken when jacking up and supporting the
vehicle. Be sure to lift and support the vehicle at the proper locations.
(a) If the vehicle is to be jacked up only at the front or
rear end, be sure to block the wheels at the opposite
end in order to ensure safety.
(b) After the vehicle is jacked up, be sure to support it on
stands. It is extremely dangerous to do any work on
a vehicle raised on a jack alone, even for a small job
that can be finished quickly.
IN–6
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
IN016–02
This glossary lists all SAE–J1930 terms and abbreviations used in this manual in compliance with SAE
recommendations, as well as their Toyota equivalents.
SAE
TOYOTA TERMS
SAE TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS
( )––ABBREVIATIONS
A/C
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
AP
Accelerator Pedal
B+
Battery Positive Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
CL
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CMP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CPP
Clutch Pedal Position
–
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
–
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
–
DFI
Direct Fuel Injection (Diesel)
DI
Distributor Ignition
DLC1
Data Link Connector 1
1: Check Connector
DLC2
Data Link Connector 2
2: Toyota Diagnosis Communication Link (TDCL)
DLC3
Data Link Connector 3
3: OBD@@@@@: [g 2] Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
ECL
Engine Control Level
ECM
Engine Control Module
Engine ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory
–
+B, Battery Voltage
–
–
Direct Injection (DI)
–
–
–
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM),
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
EI
Electronic Ignition
Toyota Distributorless Ignition (TDI)
EM
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
EPROM
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
EVAP
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
FC
Fan Control
FEEPROM
–
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable
–
Read Only Memory
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
–
FF
Flexible Fuel
–
FP
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
GEN
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
HO2S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
IN–7
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
IAC
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
IFI
Indirect Fuel Injection
IFS
Inertia Fuel–Shutoff
–
ISC
Idle Speed Control
–
KS
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
–
Indirect Injection
Manifold Pressure
Intake Vacuum
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
MC
Mixture Control
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
MFI
Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Check Engine Light
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
–
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
–
NVRAM
Non–Volatile Random Access Memory
–
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, O2 Sensor (O2S)
OBD
On–Board Diagnostic
On–Board Diagnostic (OBD)
OC
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalyst Converter (OC), CCo
OP
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
–
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
–
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
–
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
–
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
RAM
Random Access Memory
RM
Relay Module
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
SC
Supercharger
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger Bypass
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
–
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
–
SRT
System Readiness Test
–
ST
Scan Tool
–
TB
Throttle Body
TBI
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TC
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
Torque Converter
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Transmission ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
TP
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TR
Transmission Range
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
–
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
Random Access Memory (RAM)
–
–
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
Throttle Body
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
–
IN–8
INTRODUCTION
–
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
TWC
Three–Way Catalytic Converter
TWC+OC
Three–Way + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR + CCo
VAF
Volume Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
VR
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Read Switch Type)
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU–OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
WU–TWC
Warm Up Three–Way Catalytic Converter
3GR
Third Gear
–
4GR
Fourth Gear
–
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
Three–Way Catalyst (TWC)
CCRO
–
Manifold Converter
IN–9
INTRODUCTION
–
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS
MANUAL
IN01H–0R
ATF
Automatic Transaxle Fluid
B0
Overdrive Brake
B1
Second coast Brake
B2
Second Brake
B3
First and Reverse Brake
C0
Overdrive Direct Clutch
C1
Forward Clutch
C2
Direct Clutch
D
Disc
F
Flange
F0
O/D One–way Clutch
F1
No.1 One–way Clutch
F2
No.2 One–way Clutch
MP
Multipurpose
O/D
Overdirve
P
Plate
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
IN–10
INTRODUCTION
–
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
IN008–02
IN–11
INTRODUCTION
–
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
AX–1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DESCRIPTION
DESCRIPTION
AX0CH–05
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Type of Transaxle
A541E
Type of Engine
1MZ–FE
Torque Converter Clutch Stall Torque Ratio
1.8 : 1
Torque Converter Clutch Lock–up Mechanism
Gear Ratio
Transaxle
B1 Band Width
Equipped
1st Gear
2.810
2nd Gear
1.549
3rd Gear
1.000
O/D Gear
0.735
Reverse Gear
2.296
Number of Discs and Plates
O/D Direct Clutch (C0)
2/2
Forward Clutch (C1)
5/5
Direct Clutch (C2)
3/3
2nd Brake (B2)
3/3
First and Reverse Brake (B3)
6/6
O/D Brake (B0)
3/3
mm (in.)
ATF Type
Capacity liter (US qts, Imp.qts)
25 (0.98)
ATF D–@@@@@: [g 2] or DEXRON®@@@@@: [g
3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
A/T
6.75(7.1, 5.9)
D/F
0.85 (0.9, 0.7)
AX–2
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
OPERATION
1.
MECHANICAL OPERATION
AX0RF–01
AX–3
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
AX019–03
2.
FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
AX–4
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
Power from the engine transmitted to the input shaft via the torque converter clutch is then transmitted
to the planetary gears by the operation of the clutch.
By operation of the brake and one–way clutch, either the planetary carrier or the planetary sun gear
are immobilized, altering the speed of revolution of the planetary gear unit.
Shift change is carried out by altering the combination of clutch and brake operation.
Each clutch and brake operates by hydraulic pressure; gear position is decided according to the throttle
opening angle and vehicle speed, and shift change automatically occurs.
The conditions of operation for each gear position are shown on the following illustrations:
AX–5
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OPERATION
AX01A–0B
3.
HYDRAULIC CONTROL SYSTEM
The hydraulic control system is composed of the oil pump, the valve body, the solenoid valves, the accumulators, the clutches and brakes as well as the fluid passages which connect all of these components.
Based on the hydraulic pressure created by the oil pump, the hydraulic control system governs the hydraulic pressure acting on the torque converter clutch, clutches and brakes in accordance with the vehicle driving conditions.
There are three solenoid valves on the valve body.
The No.1 and No.2 solenoid vales are turned on and off by signals from the ECM to operate the shift
valves and change the gear shift position.
The SL solenoid valve is operated by signals from the ECM to engage or disengage the lock–up clutch
of the torque converter clutch.
The SLN solenoid valve is operated by signals from the ECM to control the engagement speed and
reduce gear shift shock.
AX–6
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
PREPARATION
AX02L–06
SST (SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS)
09226–10010
Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
09240–00020
Wire Gauge Set
09316–20011
Transfer Bearing Replacer
09316–60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316–00011)
Replacer Pipe
09350–32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
09308–10010
Oil Seal Puller
(09351–32032)
Counter Driven Gear Holding Tool
(09351–32040)
No.1 Piston Spring Compressor
(09351–32050)
Snap Ring Expander
(09351–32061)
Oil Pump Puller
(09351–32070)
No.2 Piston Spring Compressor
(09351–32080)
Lock Nut Wrench
Install RH retainer oil seal
AX–7
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
(09351–32100)
Drive Pinion Bearing Replacer
(09351–32120)
Overdrive Bearing Replacer
(09351–32140)
Oil Seal Replacer
(09351–32150)
Oil Seal Replacer
(09351–32190)
Measure Terminal
(09351–32200)
No.3 Piston Spring Compressor
09608–16011
Rear Hub Bearing Tool–
Remove differential side bearing
09612–65014
Steering Worm Bearing Puller
Remove pinion shaft bearing outer
race
09950–40010
Puller B Set
AX02M–02
RECOMMENDED COOL
09031–00030
Pin Punch .
AX–8
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
PREPARATION
AX02N–02
EQUIPMENT
Feeler gauge
Check major clearance.
Vernier calipers
Check length of second coast
brake piston rod.
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Check piston stroke and end play
of the output shaft.
Dial indicator
Check inside diameter of
major bushing.
Straight edge
Check side clearance of oil pump.
Torque wrench
AX01V–08
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Automatic transaxle fluid:
Dry fill
Drain and refill
Classification
ATF D–@@@@@: [g 2] or
6.75 liters (7.10 US qts, 5.94 Imp.qts)
2.5 liters (2.6 US qts, 2.2 Imp.qts)
DEXRON®@@@@@: [g
3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
ATF D–@@@@@: [g 2] or
Differential oil
0.85 liters (0.89 US qts, 0.75 Imp.qts)
DEXRON®@@@@@: [g
3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
AX02P–02
SSM (SPECIAL SERVICE MATERIALS)
08826–00090
Seal Packing 1281,
THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
(FIPG)
Differential LH bearing retainer
Differential RH retainer
08833–00070
Adhesive 1324,
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Differential RH retainer set bolt
AX–9
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX02Q–02
COMPONENTS
AX–10
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–11
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–12
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX–13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX0TT–02
SEPARATE BASIC SUBASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SHIFT CONTROL CABLE BRACKET
2. REMOVE UNION AND ELBOW
(a) Remove the manual shift lever.
(b) Using a open end wrench, remove the union and elbow.
(c) Remove the O–rings from the union and elbow.
3. REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Pry off the lock washer and remove the manual valve
shaft nut.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and pull out the park/neutral position
switch.
4.
REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE RETAINING BOLT AND
PLATE
AX–14
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
5. REMOVE T/M REVOLUTION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and T/M revolution sensor.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the T/M revolution sensor.
6.
REMOVE TRANSAXLE CASE UPPER COVER
7. REMOVE OIL PAN AND GASKET
(a) Remove the 17 bolts.
(b) Remove the oil pan by lifting transaxle case.
NOTICE: Do not turn the transaxle over as this will contaminate the valve body with the foreign materials in the bottom
of the oil pan.
(c)
Place the transaxle on wooden blocks to prevent damage
to the oil pipe bracket.
8.
EXHAUST PARTICLES IN PAN
Remove the magnet and use it to collect any steel chips.
Lock carefully at the chips and particles in the oil pan and
on magnet to anticipate what type of wear you will find in
the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non–magnetic): bushing wear
9.
REMOVE OIL PIPE BRACKET AND STRAINER
AX–15
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
10. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE BODY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and detent spring.
(b) Remove the 5 bolts and manual valve body with the
manual valve.
(c) Remove the manual valve from the manual valve body.
11. REMOVE OIL PIPES
(a) Remove the bolt.
(b) Pry up both pipe ends with a large screwdriver and remove the 6 pipes.
12. DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
13. REMOVE CONNECTOR CLAMP AND PIPE RETAINER
AX–16
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
14. REMOVE B3 APPLY PIPE
Pry up the pipe with a screwdriver and remove the pipe.
15. REMOVE VALVE BODY
(a) Remove the 9 bolts.
(b) Remove the wire harness clamp.
(c)
Disconnect the throttle cable from the cam, and remove
the valve body.
16. REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE
AX–17
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
17. REMOVE SOLENOID WIRING
Remove the bolt and the solenoid wiring.
18. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
19. REMOVE ACCUMULATOR PISTONS AND SPRINGS
(a) Loosen the 4 bolts one turn at a time until the spring tension is released.
(b) Remove the cover and gasket.
(c) Remove the C1 accumulator piston and spring.
(d) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
(e) Pop out pistons for C2 and B2 into a rag, using low–pressure compressed air (98 kPa, 1 kgf/cm2, 14 psi).
(f) Remove the O–rings from the pistons.
AX–18
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
20. MEASURE PISTON STROKE SECOND COAST
BRAKE
(a) Apply a small amount of paint to the piston rod at the point
it meets the case.
(b) Using SST, measure the piston stroke while applying and
releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8 kgf/cm2,
57–114 psi).
SST 09240–00020
Maximum thrust clearance:
2.0–3.5 mm (0.079–0.138 in.)
If the piston stroke exceeds the limit, inspect the second
coast brake band.
21. REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
(a) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014
(b) Applying compressed air to the oil hole, remove the second coast brake cover, piston assembly and spring.
(c) Remove the 2 O–rings from the cover.
AX–19
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
22. STAND TRANSAXLE ENGINE SIDE UPWARD
23. REMOVE OIL PUMP
NOTICE: Before removing the oil pump, remove the second coast brake piston.
(a) Remove the 7 bolts.
(b) Using SST, pull out the oil pump from the transaxle case.
SST 09350–32014
24. REMOVE O–RING FROM OIL PUMP
25. REMOVE DIRECT CLUTCH AND FORWARD CLUTCH
26. SEPARATE DIRECT CLUTCH AND FORWARD
CLUTCH
(a) Separate the direct clutch and forward clutch.
(b) Remove the thrust washer from direct clutch.
AX–20
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
27. REMOVE BEARING FROM FORWARD CLUTCH
28. REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND
(a) Push the pin with a small screwdriver and remove it from
the bolt hole of the oil pump mounting.
(b) Remove the brake band.
29. REMOVE FRONT PLANETARY RING GEAR
30. REMOVE FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Remove the front planetary gear.
(b) Remove the 2 bearings from the planetary gear.
AX–21
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
31. REMOVE SUN GEAR AND SUN GEAR INPUT DRUM
(a) Remove the sun gear and the sun gear input drum.
(b) Remove the thrust washer from sun gear input drum.
32. CHECK OPERATION OF SECOND BRAKE PISTON
Apply compressed air into the case passage and confirm
that the piston moves.
If the piston does not move, disassembe and inspect.
33. REMOVE SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND GUIDE
34. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE DRUM
(a) Remove the snap ring.
AX–22
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Remove the second brake drum.
35. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE PISTON RETURN SPRING
36. REMOVE NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
37. REMOVE PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
38. REMOVE SECOND BRAKE DRUM GASKET
Remove the gasket.
AX–23
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
39. REMOVE NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND REAR PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the No.2 one–way clutch and rear planetary
gear.
(c)
Remove the thrust washer from the rear planetary gear.
40. REMOVE REAR PLANETARY RING GEAR
(a) Remove the rear planetary ring gear.
(b) Remove the bearing from the ring gear.
41. CHECK FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
(a) Check the operation of the first and reverse brake piston.
Apply compressed air into the case passage and confirm
that the piston moves.
If the piston does not move, disassemble and inspect.
AX–24
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Using a filler gauge, check the pack clearance of the first
and reverse brake.
Clearance: 1.92–2.68 mm (0.0756–0.1055 in.)
42. REMOVE FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES OF FIRST
AND REVERSE BRAKE
(a) Remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the flange, 6 discs and plates.
43. TURN TRANSAXLE CASE AROUND
44. REMOVE OVERDRIVE UNIT
(a) Remove the 13 bolts.
(b) Tap on the circumference of the overdrive case with a
plastic hammer to remove the overdrive case and gasket.
AX–25
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
Remove the overdrive planetary gear from transaxle
case.
(d) Remove the overdrive brake drum from the transaxle
case.
(e) Remove the overdrive clutch apply gasket and overdrive
brake apply gasket.
45. REMOVE FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE PISTON
(a) Remove the piston return spring.
Place SST, compress the return spring evenly by
tightening the bolt gradually.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32040)
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Remove the SST.
Remove the return spring from the case.
AX–26
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Apply compressed air into the passage of the case to remove the piston.
HINT: Hold the piston so it is not slanted and blow with the
gun slightly away from the oil hole.
(c)
If the piston does not pop out with compressed air, use
needle–nose pliers to remove it.
(d) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
(e) Remove the snap ring.
46. REMOVE PARKING LOCK PAWL BRACKET AND
GUIDE
AX–27
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
47. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE SHAFT
(a) Using a chisel and hammer, cut the collar.
(b) Remove the retaining spring.
(c)
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the pin.
(d) Slide out the shaft from the transaxle case and remove
the manual valve lever and parking lock rod.
48. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE SHAFT OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal.
AX–28
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
49. REMOVE PIN, SPRING AND PARKING LOCK PAWL
AX02S–04
DIFFERENTIAL COMPONENT PARTS
REMOVAL
1.
MEASURE DIFFERENTIAL TOTAL PRELOAD
Using a small torque wrench, measure the total preload
and make a note of it.
2. REMOVE LH BEARING RETAINER
(a) Remove the 6 bolts.
(b) Using a large screwdriver, remove the LH bearing retainer.
NOTICE: Wrap the screwdriver tip in a rag, etc. to avoid
damaging the case and retainer.
3. REMOVE RH RETAINER
(a) Remove the 5 bolts.
AX–29
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(b) Using a large screwdriver, remove the RH retainer.
NOTICE: Wrap the screwdriver tip in a rag, etc. to avoid
damaging the case and retainer.
4. REMOVE CARRIER COVER
(a) Remove the 10 bolts.
(b) Tap the carrier cover with a plastic hammer to remove it.
(c)
Remove the apply gasket.
5.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Remove the differential case, outer case and shim from
the transaxle case.
AX–30
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
6. REMOVE TRANSAXLE CAP
(a) Remove the bolt.
(b) Using pliers, pull out the drive pinion cap.
(c) Remove the O–rings from the cap.
7.
MEASURE DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
Using a small torque wrench, measure the drive pinion
preload.
Preload (Reused bearing at starting):
0.5–0.8 N·m (5–8 kgf·cm, 4.3–6.9 in.·lbf)
The total preload measured in step 1 minus the drive pinion preload equals 0.1–0.2 N·m (1.3–2.0 kgf·cm, 1.1–1.7
in.·lbf). If the result is not within this specification, the side
bearing preload is suspect.
8. REMOVE COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR
(a) Using a chisel and hammer, loosen the staked part of the
nut.
(b) Using SST to hold the gear, remove the nut.
SST 09330–00021, 09350–32014 (09351–32032)
AX–31
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
Using SST, remove the gear and bearing.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32061)
9. REMOVE OUTER RACE, SPACER AND OIL SLINGER
(a) Using SST, remove the outer race with oil slinger and
spacer.
SST 09350–32014 (09308–10010)
(b) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
10. REMOVE DRIVE PINION
(a) Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(b) Install the bar into the case hole to drive out the drive pinion.
(c) Using a press, drive out the drive pinion from transaxle
case.
AX–32
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
(d) Remove the bearing cage from drive pinion.
(e) Using SST, press out the bearing.
SST 09950–00020
AX–33
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS REMOVAL
AX02T–07
GENERAL NOTES
The instructions here are organized so that you work on only one component group at a time.
This will help avoid confusion from similar–looking parts of different subassemblies being on your workbench at the same time.
The component groups are inspected and repaired from the converter housing side.
As much as possible, complete the inspection, repair and assembly before proceeding to the next component group. If a component group cannot be assembled because parts are being ordered, be sure to keep
all parts of that group in a separate container while proceeding with disassembly, inspection, repair and
assembly of other component groups.
Recommended fluid for the automatic transaxle: ATF D–@@@@@: [g 2] or DEXRON®@@@@@: [g
3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
1. GENERAL CLEANING NOTES:
(a) All disassembled parts should be washed clean and any fluid passages and holes blown through with
compressed air.
(b) When using compressed air to dry parts, always aim away from yourself to prevent accidentally spraying automatic transaxle fluid or kerosene in your face.
(c) The recommended automatic transaxle fluid or kerosene should be used for cleaning.
2. PARTS ARRANGEMENT:
(a) After cleaning, the parts should be arranged in the correct order to allow efficient inspection, repairs,
and reassembly.
(b) When disassembling a valve body, be sure to keep each valve together with the corresponding spring.
(c) New brakes and clutches that are to be used for replacement must be soaked in transaxle fluid for at
least fifteen minutes before assembly.
3. GENERAL ASSEMBLY:
(a) All oil seal rings, clutch discs, clutch plates, rotating parts, and sliding surfaces should be coated with
transmission fluid prior to reassembly.
(b) All gaskets and rubber O–rings should be replaced.
(c) Make sure that the ends of a snap ring are not aligned with one of the cutouts and are installed in the
groove correctly.
(d) If a worn bushing is to be replaced, the subassembly containing that bushing must be replaced.
(e) Check thrust bearings and races for wear or damage. Replace if necessary.
(f) Use petroleum jelly to keep parts in place.
AX–34
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
SECOND COAST BRAKE
AX02U–02
COMPONENTS
SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
DISASSEMBLY
1.
AX02V–02
REMOVE OIL SEAL RING
Remove the oil seal ring from the piston.
2. REMOVE PISTON ROD
(a) Remove the E–ring while pushing the piston with needle–
nose pliers.
AX–35
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
(b) Remove the inner spring, plate washer and piston rod.
AX02W–03
SECOND COAST BRAKE COMPONENT
INSPECTION
If the lining of the brake band is peeling off or discolored,
or even part of the printed mark is defaced, replace the
brake band.
AX02X–03
SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
ASSEMBLY
1.
SELECT PISTON ROD
If the band is OK but piston stroke not within the standard
value, select a new piston rod.
Piston stroke:
2.0–3.5 mm (0.079–0.138 in.)
There are 2 lengths of piston rod.
Piston rod length:
95.2 mm (3.748 in.)
96.3 mm (3.791 in.)
2. INSTALL PISTON ROD
(a) Install the plate washer and inner spring to the piston rod.
AX–36
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND COAST BRAKE
(b) Install the E–ring while pushing the piston.
3. INSTALL OIL SEAL RING
(a) Apply ATF to the oil seal ring.
(b) Install the oil seal ring to the piston.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends more than necessary.
AX–37
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OIL PUMP
OIL PUMP
AX02Y–02
COMPONENTS
OIL PUMP DISASSEMBLY
AX02Z–02
1.
REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
Remove the 2 oil seal rings from the stator shaft back
side.
2.
REMOVE THRUST WASHER FROM STATOR SHAFT
BACK SIDE
AX–38
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OIL PUMP
3.
REMOVE STATOR SHAFT
Remove the 11 bolts and stator shaft.
HINT: Keep the gears in assembly order.
4.
REMOVE FRONT OIL SEAL
Pry off the oil seal with a screwdriver.
AX030–06
OIL PUMP BUSHING INSPECTION
1.
CHECK BODY CLEARANCE OF DRIVEN GEAR
Push the driven gear to one side of the body.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard body clearance:
0.07–0.15 mm (0.0028–0.0059 in.)
Maximum body clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
2.
CHECK TIP CLEARANCE OF DRIVEN GEAR
Measure between the driven gear teeth and the crescent–shaped part of the pump body.
Standard tip clearance:
0.11–0.14 mm (0.0043–0.0055 in.)
Maximum tip clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than the maximum, replace
the oil pump body subassembly.
AX–39
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
3.
–
OIL PUMP
CHECK SIDE CLEARANCE OF BOTH GEARS
Using a steel straightedge and feeler gauge, measure the
side clearance of both gears.
Standard side clearance:
0.002–0.005 mm (0.0008–0.0020 in.)
Maximum side clearance:
0.100 mm (0.0039 in.)
There are 3 different thicknesses for drive and driven
gears.
Drive and driven gear thickness
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
A
9.440–9.456 (0.3717–0.3723)
B
9.456–9.474 (0.3723–0.3730)
C
9.474–9.490 (0.3730–0.3736)
If the thickest gear can not make the side clearance within
standard specification, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
4.
CHECK OIL PUMP BODY BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
oil pump body bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
38.18 mm (1.5031 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the oil pump body subassembly.
5.
CHECK STATOR SHAFT BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter stator
shaft bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
21.57 mm (0.8492 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the stator shaft.
AX031–02
OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, install a new oil seal. The seal
end should be flush with the outer edge of the pump body.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32140)
AX–40
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
–
OIL PUMP
INSTALL DRIVEN GEAR AND DRIVE GEAR
Make sure the top of the gears are facing upward.
3. INSTALL STATOR SHAFT TO PUMP BODY
(a) Align the stator shaft with each bolt hole.
(b) Torque the 11 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
4. INSTALL THRUST WASHER
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly.
(b) Align the tab of the washer with the hollow of the pump
body.
5.
INSTALL OIL SEAL RINGS
Install the 2 oil seal rings to the stator shaft back side.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends more than necessary.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
6.
CHECK PUMP DRIVE GEAR ROTATION
Turn the drive gear with 2 screwdrivers and make sure it
rotates smoothly.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
AX–41
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
DIRECT CLUTCH
AX032–02
COMPONENTS
DIRECT CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
AX033–05
1. CHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Install the direct clutch on the oil pump.
(b) Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the direct clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8
kg/cm2, 57–114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
0.91–1.35 mm (0.0358–0.0531 in.)
If the piston stroke is greater than the maximum, inspect
each component.
AX–42
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
3.
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
REMOVE SNAP RING FROM CLUTCH DRUM
REMOVE FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
4. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the
springs with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(b) Remove the snap ring with snap ring pliers.
(c)
Remove the piston return spring.
5. REMOVE CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Install the direct clutch onto the oil pump.
(b) Apply compressed air to the oil pump to remove the piston
(if the piston does not come out completely, use needle–
nose pliers to remove it).
(c) Remove the direct clutch from the oil pump.
(d) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX–43
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
AX034–03
DIRECT CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying low–pressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
3.
CHECK DIRECT CLUTCH BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
direct clutch bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
48.27 mm (1.9004 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the direct clutch.
DIRECT CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
AX035–06
1. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON IN DIRECT CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install new O–rings to the piston. Coat the O–rings with
ATF.
(b) Being careful not to damage the O–rings, press the piston
into the drum with the cup side up.
2. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place the return spring and snap ring onto the piston.
AX–44
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIRECT CLUTCH
(b) Place SST on the spring retainer, and compress the return spring with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(c) Install the snap ring using snap ring pliers. Be sure the
end gap of snap ring is aligned with the spring retainer
claw.
3. INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
(a) Install plates and discs.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–P–D
(b) Install the flange with the flat end facing downward.
4.
INSTALL SNAP RING
Check that the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of the cutouts.
5. RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Install the direct clutch on the oil pump.
(b) Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the direct clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8
kgf/cm2, 57–114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
0.91–1.35 mm (0.0358–0.0531 in.)
If the piston stroke is non–standard, select another
flange.
HINT: There are 2 different thickness for the flange.
Flange thickness:
2.70 mm (0.1063 in.)
3.00 mm (0.1181 in.)
AX–45
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
FORWARD CLUTCH
AX036–02
COMPONENTS
FORWARD CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
1.
AX037–04
CHECK PISTON STROKE OF FORWARD CLUTCH
Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the forward clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8
kgf/cm2, 57–114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
1.79–2.21 mm (0.0704–0.0870 in.)
each component.
AX–46
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
2.
REMOVE SNAP RING FROM CLUTCH DRUM
3.
REMOVE FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
4. REMOVE RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the
springs with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(b) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(c)
Remove the return spring.
5. REMOVE CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Apply compressed air into the oil passage to remove the
piston.
If the piston does not come out, use needle–nose pliers
to remove it.
AX–47
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
6.
IF NECESSARY, REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
Remove the 3 oil seal rings from the shaft.
AX038–03
FORWARD CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying low–pressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX039–04
FORWARD CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OIL SEAL RINGS
Install the 3 oil seal rings to the shaft.
NOTICE: Do not spread the ring ends more than necessary.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
AX–48
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
2. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON TO CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install the 2 new O–rings to the piston.
(b) Coat the O–ring with ATF.
(c) Press the piston into the drum with the cup side up, being
careful not to damage the O–rings.
3. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRINGS
(a) Place the return spring and snap ring onto the piston.
(b) Place SST on the spring retainer, and compress the
springs with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070)
(c) Install the snap ring with snap ring pliers.
Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
the spring retainer claw.
4. INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
(a) Install the plates and discs.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D
(b) Install the flange with the flat end facing downward.
5.
INSTALL SNAP RING
Check that the end gap of snap ring is not aligned with one
of the cutouts.
AX–49
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
6.
–
FORWARD CLUTCH
RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF FORWARD CLUTCH
Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the forward clutch piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8
kgf/cm2, 57–114 psi).
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
Piston stroke:
1.79–2.21 mm (0.0704–0.0870 in.)
If the piston stroke is non–standard, select another
flange.
HINT: There are 2 different thicknesses for the flange.
Flange thickness:
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
2.70 mm (1.0630 in.)
AX–50
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
AX03A–02
COMPONENTS
AX0TU–03
NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND SUN GEAR
DISASSEMBLY
1.
CHECK OPERATION OF NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Hold the sun gear and turn the hub. The hub should turn
freely clockwise and should lock counterclockwise.
2.
REMOVE NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH FROM SUN GEAR
While turning the hub clockwise, remove the No.1 one–
way clutch from the sun gear.
AX–51
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
3. REMOVE SUN GEAR FROM DRUM
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring from the
drum.
(b) Remove the sun gear from the drum.
4.
CHECK SUN GEAR BUSHINGS
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
sun gear bushings.
Maximum inside diameter:
22.59 mm (0.8894 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the sun gear.
AX0TV–01
NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND SUN GEAR
ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL SUN GEAR TO DRUM
(a) Install the sun gear to the drum.
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring to drum.
2.
3.
INSTALL NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH ON SUN GEAR
While turning the hub clockwise, slide the No.1 one–way
clutch onto the sun gear.
RECHECK OPERATION OF NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
AX03D–02
PLANETARY RING GEAR INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT RING GEAR FLANGE BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
flange bushing.
Maximum inside diameter:
30.08 mm (1.1842 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the flange.
AX–52
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
2. REMOVE RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the flange from the ring gear.
3. INSTALL RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Position the flange into the ring gear.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR INSPECTION
AX03E–03
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.16–0.56 mm (0.0063–0.0220 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.61 mm (0.0240 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
AX–53
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND BRAKE
SECOND BRAKE
AX03F–02
COMPONENTS
AX03G–03
SECOND BRAKE PISTON DISASSEMBLY
REMOVE SECOND BRAKE PISTON
(a) Apply compressed air to the oil hole to remove the piston.
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX–54
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SECOND BRAKE
AX03H–03
SECOND BRAKE COMPONENT INSPECTION
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX03J–06
SECOND BRAKE PISTON ASSEMBLY
INSTALL PISTON
(a) Coat a new O–ring with ATF.
(b) Install the 2 new O–rings on the piston.
(c)
Press the piston into the drum, being careful not to damage the O–rings.
AX–55
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
AX03K–02
COMPONENTS
NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY
AX03L–02
1.
CHECK OPERATION OF NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Hold the outer race and turn the rear planetary gear. The
rear planetary gear should turn freely counterclockwise
and should lock clockwise.
2.
SEPARATE NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND REAR
PLANETARY GEAR
REMOVE THRUST WASHER
Remove the thrust washer from the rear side of planetary
gear.
3.
AX–56
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
4.
REMOVE NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH FROM OUTER
RACE
(a) Remove the 2 snap rings and retainers from both sides.
(b) Remove the No.2 one–way clutch from the outer race.
AX03M–03
REAR PLANETARY GEAR INSPECTION
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.16–0.56 mm (0.0063–0.0220 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.61 mm (0.0240 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
AX03N–02
1. INSTALL ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install the No.2 one–way clutch into the outer race, facing
the flange side of the No.2 one–way clutch toward the
shiny side of the outer race.
(b) Install the 2 retainers and snap rings to both sides.
AX–57
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
REAR PLANETARY GEAR
2.
INSTALL PLANETARY GEAR INTO NO.2 ONE–WAY
CLUTCH
Install the planetary gear into the No.2 one–way clutch,
facing the inner race of the rear planetary gear toward the
black side of the No.2 one–way clutch outer race.
3.
CHECK OPERATION OF NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
4. INSTALL THRUST WASHER
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly.
(b) Align the tab of the washer with the hollows of the carrier.
RING GEAR FLANGE REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the flange from the ring gear.
2. INSTALL RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Position the flange into the ring gear.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install the snap ring.
AX03P–02
AX–58
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
AX03Q–02
COMPONENTS
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
COMPONENTS INSPECTION
AX03R–03
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGES
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flanges are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX–59
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX03S–02
COMPONENTS
AX–60
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX03T–03
OVERDRIVE BRAKE DISASSEMBLY
1. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) While pushing the return spring, remove the snap ring
with a screwdriver.
(b) Remove the piston return spring.
2.
REMOVE PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
3.
REMOVE PISTON FROM DRUM
Apply compressed air to oil hole to remove the piston.
HINT: Blow with the gun slightly away from the oil hole,
and be careful that the piston does not tilt.
4.
REMOVE O–RINGS
Remove the inner and outer O–rings from the piston.
AX–61
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX03U–03
OVERDRIVE BRAKE INSPECTION
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flange are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
AX03V–05
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
DISASSEMBLY
1.
CHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 5–8 kgf/cm2,
57–114 psi).
Piston stroke:
1.75–2.49 mm (0.0689–0.0980 in.)
2.
3.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
If the piston stroke is greater than the maximum, inspect
each component.
REMOVE OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH FROM CASE
REMOVE BEARING AND RACE FROM CLUTCH
DRUM AND CASE
AX–62
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
4.
REMOVE SNAP RING WITH SCREWDRIVER
5.
REMOVE FLANGES, DISCS AND PLATES
6. REMOVE PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place SST on the spring retainer and compress the spring
with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070, 09351–32200)
(b) Remove the snap ring.
(c)
Remove the piston return spring.
7. REMOVE PISTON FROM CLUTCH DRUM
(a) Install the clutch drum on the case.
(b) Apply compressed air to the pressure apply hole of the
case.
(c) Remove the piston from the clutch drum.
If the piston does not come out completely, use needle–
nose pliers to remove it.
(d) Remove the clutch drum from the case.
AX–63
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
8.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
REMOVE O–RINGS
Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
AX03W–03
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH INSPECTION
1. INSPECT OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Check that the check ball is free by shaking the piston.
(b) Check that the valve does not leak by applying low–pressure compressed air.
2.
INSPECT DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGES
Check if the sliding surfaces of the discs, plates and
flanges are worn or burnt. If necessary, replace them.
HINT:
If the lining of the disc is peeling off or discolored, or
even if a part of the printed numbers are defaced, replace all discs.
Before assembling new discs, soak them in ATF for
at least 15 minutes.
3.
CHECK DIRECT CLUTCH BUSHING
Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the
2 direct clutch bushings.
Maximum inside diameter:
22.13 mm (0.8713 in.)
If the inside diameter is greater than the maximum, replace the direct clutch drum.
AX03X–06
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL CLUTCH PISTON
(a) Install new O–rings to the piston. Coat the O–rings with
ATF.
AX–64
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
(b) Press the piston into the drum with the cup side up, being
careful not to damage the O–ring.
2. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Install the return spring and seat snap ring in place.
(b) Place SST on the spring retainer, and compress the
spring with a press.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32070, 09351–32200)
(c) Install the snap ring with a screwdriver. Be sure end gap
of snap ring is aligned with the groove of the clutch drum.
3.
INSTALL PLATES, DISCS AND FLANGE
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–Flange
4.
INSTALL SNAP RING
Be sure end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the
groove of the clutch drum.
AX–65
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
5. INSTALL BEARING AND RACE
(a) Coat the bearing with petroleum jelly and install it facing
the race side downward to the clutch drum.
Bearing outer diameter: 46.3 mm (1.823 in.)
Bearing inner diameter: 26.2 mm (1.031 in.)
(b) Coat the race with petroleum jelly and install it to the case.
Race outer diameter: 43.0 mm (1.693 in.)
Race inner diameter: 24.5 mm (0.965 in.)
6.
INSTALL DIRECT CLUTCH ON CASE
7.
RECHECK PISTON STROKE OF DIRECT CLUTCH
Install a dial indicator and measuring terminal (SST) together, measure the piston stroke while applying and releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8 kgf/cm2,
57–114 psi).
Piston stroke:
1.75–2.49 mm (0.0689–0.0980 in.)
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32190)
AX03Y–03
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR DISASSEMBLY
1. CHECK OPERATION OF ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install the O/D direct clutch into the one–way clutch.
(b) Hold the O/D direct clutch and turn the intermediate shaft.
The shaft should turn freely clockwise and should lock
counterclockwise.
(c) Remove the O/D direct clutch.
AX–66
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
2. CHECK COUNTER DRIVE GEAR PRELOAD
(a) Hold the O/D planetary gear in a vise with soft jaws.
HINT: Do not let the counter drive gear touch the vise.
(b) Using a tension gauge, measure the preload.
Preload (at starting):
9.2–15.3 N (940–1,560 g, 2.1–3.4 lb)
HINT: Turn the counter drive gear right and left several
times before measuring the preload.
3. REMOVE O/D ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND OUTER RACE
(a) Remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the retaining plate.
(c) Remove the O/D one–way clutch with outer race.
(d) Remove the 2 retainers from both sides of the O/D one–
way clutch.
AX–67
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
(e) Remove the O/D one–way clutch from the outer race.
HINT: Note the direction of the one–way clutch.
4.
5.
REMOVE NO.3 PLANETARY THRUST WASHER
REMOVE PLUGS FROM PLANETARY GEAR
Remove the 4 plugs with a magnetic finger.
NOTICE: Be careful not to lose them.
6. REMOVE ADJUSTING NUT AND LOCKING WASHER
(a) Pry off the locking washer.
(b) Using SST, loosen the adjusting nut.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32080)
(c) Remove the adjusting nut and locking washer.
7.
REMOVE INTERMEDIATE SHAFT BEARING
Using SST, press out the bearing from the shaft.
SST 09950–00020
AX–68
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
8.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
REMOVE COUNTER DRIVE GEAR AND FRONT
BEARING
Press out the gear and bearing together.
9. REMOVE REAR BEARING
(a) Using SST, press out the bearing.
SST 09950–00020
(b) Tag the bearings to show the location for reassembly.
10. REMOVE O/D PLANETARY RING GEAR FROM
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) While pulling up the ring gear, compress the snap ring
with needle–nose pliers and remove it from the groove.
(b) Remove the ring gear from the counter drive gear.
(c)
Remove the snap ring from the ring gear.
AX–69
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
11. REMOVE OUTER RACES FROM COUNTER DRIVE
GEAR
(a) Drive out the 2 races with a brass bar and hammer.
(b) Tag the races to show the location for reassembly.
12. REMOVE SNAP RING FROM COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
OVERDRIVE PLANETARY GEAR
INSPECTION
AX03Z–03
MEASURE PLANETARY PINION GEAR THRUST
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.16–0.56 mm (0.0063–0.0220 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.61 mm (0.0240 in.)
If the clearance is greater then the maximum, replace the
planetary gear assembly.
AX–70
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX040–03
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL SNAP RING INTO COUNTER GEAR
Install the snap ring with a screwdriver.
2.
INSTALL OUTER RACES INTO COUNTER DRIVE
GEAR
Using SST, press in the 2 outer races to both sides of the
gear.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120, 09351–32150)
HINT: Press in the 2 outer races until they touch the snap
ring. Tap the races in straight, so that they do not tilt.
3.
INSTALL OVERDRIVE PLANETARY RING GEAR INTO
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) Install the snap ring to the ring gear.
(b) While pushing down the ring gear, squeeze the snap ring
end with needle–nose pliers, and install it into the groove.
4.
INSTALL REAR BEARING
Using SST, press in the bearing onto the shaft.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
HINT: Press in the bearing until the side surface of the inner race touches the planetary carrier.
AX–71
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
5.
INSTALL COUNTER DRIVE GEAR AND FRONT BEARING
(a) Install the gear onto the shaft, and mesh the ring gear with
the planetary pinions.
(b) Place the front bearing on to the shaft.
(c)
Using SST, press in the bearing until there is slight play
between the bearings.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
HINT: Hold the ring gear to prevent it from falling.
6.
INSTALL INTERMEDIATE SHAFT BEARING
Using SST, press in the bearing until it slightly touches the
front bearing of the counter drive gear.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
HINT: The counter drive gear can be turned lightly.
7.
PLACE NEW LOCKING WASHER
8.
INSTALL ADJUSTING NUT AND ADJUST PRELOAD
OF COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) Hold the overdrive planetary gear in a vise with soft jaws.
(b) Using SST, tighten the adjusting nut until the following
gear starting load is reached on the tension gauge.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32080)
Preload (at starting):
9.2–15.3 N (940–1,560 g, 2.1–3.4 lb)
AX–72
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
HINT: Turn the counter drive gear right and left several
times before measuring the preload.
Lock the adjusting nut with one locking washer tab. Bend
the locking washer tab until it is flat with the adjusting nut
groove.
9.
INSTALL NO.3 OVERDRIVE PLANETARY THRUST
WASHER
10. INSTALL PINION SHAFT PLUGS
Install the 4 plugs into the pinion shaft.
11. INSTALL OVERDRIVE ONE–WAY CLUTCH AND RETAINING PLATE
(a) Install the one–way clutch into the outer race.
(b) Install the 2 retainers on both sides of the one–way clutch.
(c)
Install the one–way clutch into the overdrive planetary
gear.
HINT: Be sure that the one–way clutch is installed in the
correct direction.
(d) Install the retaining plate.
AX–73
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
(e) Install the snap ring.
12. CHECK OPERATION OF O/D ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Install the overdrive direct clutch into the one–way clutch.
(b) Hold the overdrive direct clutch and turn the intermediate
shaft. The shaft should turn freely clockwise and should
lock counterclockwise.
(c) Remove the overdrive direct clutch.
AX041–02
OVERDRIVE CASE DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE C0 ACCUMULATOR PISTON FROM OVERDRIVE CASE
(a) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(b) Remove the retaining plate and 2 springs.
(c) Remove the accumulator piston.
(d) Remove the O–ring from the piston.
AX–74
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
REMOVE OIL SEAL RINGS
AX042–02
OVERDRIVE CASE ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OIL SEAL RINGS ON OVERDRIVE CASE
Install the 2 oil seal rings to the overdrive case groove,
then snug them down by squeezing their ends together.
HINT: After installing the oil seal rings, check that they
move smoothly.
2.
INSTALL C0 ACCUMULATOR PISTON TO OVERDRIVE CASE
(a) Install a new O–ring to the accumulator piston.
(b) Coat the O–ring with ATF.
(c)
Install the accumulator piston, 2 springs and retaining
plate.
(d) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
AX–75
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
AX043–05
OVERDRIVE BRAKE ASSEMBLY
1. INSTALL PISTON INTO DRUM
(a) Install new O–rings to the piston.
Coat the new O–rings with ATF.
(b) Press the piston into the drum, being careful not to damage the O–rings.
2.
INSTALL FLANGE, DISCS AND PLATES
Install the flange, discs and plates.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
Flange–D–P–D–P–D–P
3.
POSITION PISTON RETURN SPRING
AX–76
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
OVERDRIVE UNIT
4.
INSTALL SNAP RING INTO CASE
Be sure the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with
one of cutouts.
5.
INSTALL OVERDRIVE PLANETARY GEAR ONTO OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
While turning the overdrive planetary gear clockwise,
install it onto the overdrive direct clutch.
HINT: If the overdrive planetary gear is properly installed
onto the direct clutch, the counter drive gear height from
the overdrive case will be about 24 mm (0.94 in.).
AX–77
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
VALVE BODY
AX044–02
COMPONENTS
VALVE BODY DISASSEMBLY
AX0TW–01
NOTICE: When disassembling the valve body, be careful
not to damage or deform the plate which overhangs the
valve body.
1. REMOVE SOLENOIDS
(a) Remove No.1 and No.2 solenoids with the retainer.
NOTICE: When removing the solenoid, do not use a screwdriver, etc. to pry up the solenoid.
(b) Remove the O–ring from each solenoid.
(c) Remove the No.3 solenoid.
(d) Remove the O–ring from the solenoid.
AX–78
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
2.
–
VALVE BODY
REMOVE LOCK PLATE
3. REMOVE B0 ACCUMULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts.
(b) Remove the B0 accumulator assembly.
4. DISASSEMBLE B0 ACCUMULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Applying compressed air to the cylinder hole, remove the
piston and spring.
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the piston.
5. REMOVE NO.4 SOLENOID
(a) Remove the No.4 solenoid.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the solenoid.
6.
REMOVE NO.1 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER
Remove the 5 bolts and No.1 lower valve body cover.
AX–79
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
7.
REMOVE OIL STRAINER, NO.1 LOWER VALVE BODY
COVER GASKETS AND CHECK VALVE
(a) Remove the 2 gaskets and plate from the lower valve
body.
(b) Remove the oil strainer, check valve and spring.
8.
REMOVE PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
9.
REMOVE NO.2 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER, OIL
STRAINER, CHECK BALLS AND VIBRATING STOPPER
Remove the 11 bolts and lower valve body cover.
(b) Remove the 2 check balls, oil strainer and vibrating stopper.
AX–80
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
10. REMOVE NO.2 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER GASKETS AND CHECK BALLS
(a) Remove the 2 screws from the lower valve body cover.
(b) Remove the 2 gaskets and plate.
(c)
Remove the 3 check balls from the cover.
11. REMOVE BOLTS FROM UPPER VALVE BODY
Remove the 3 bolts.
12. LIFT OFF UPPER VALVE BODY AND NO.1 PLATE AS
A SINGLE UNIT
Hold No.1 plate to the upper valve body and lift off the upper valve body.
HINT: Be careful that the check balls and oil strainer do
not fall out.
AX–81
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
13. REMOVE 2 CHECK BALLS AND VIBRATING STOPPER FROM UPPER VALVE BODY
14. REMOVE 2 OIL STRAINERS AND CHECK BALL FROM
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX0TX–01
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL 2 CHECK BALLS AND VIBRATING STOPPER TO UPPER VALVE BODY
2.
INSTALL 2 OIL STRAINERS AND CHECK BALL TO
LOWER VALVE BODY
3.
POSITION PLATE AND NEW GASKETS ON UPPER
VALVE BODY
Position new No.1 gasket, plate and the new No.2 gasket
on the upper valve body.
HINT: Since No.1 gasket and No.2 gasket are similar, use
the illustration below to discriminate between them.
AX–82
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
4.
PLACE UPPER VALVE BODY WITH PLATE AND GASKETS ON LOWER VALVE BODY
Hold the upper valve body, plate and gaskets securely so
they do not separate.
Align each bolt hole in the valve bodies with the gaskets
and plate.
5.
INSTALL AND FINGER TIGHTEN BOLTS IN UPPER
VALVE BODY TO SECURE LOWER VALVE BODY
Install and finger tighten the 3 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 44 mm (1.732 in.)
Bolt B: 16 mm (0.630 in.)
6.
INSTALL NO.2 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER GASKETS, PLATE AND 3 CHECK BALLS
(a) Install the 3 check balls into the No.2 lower valve body
cover.
AX–83
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
(b) Position a new gasket and plate and then another new
gasket.
HINT: Both gaskets are identical.
(c)
Install the 2 screws.
8. INSTALL NO.2 LOWER VALVE BODY COVER
(a) Position the No.2 lower valve body cover.
(b) Install and finger tighten the 11 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 40 mm (1.575 in.)
Bolt B: 44 mm (1.732 in.)
Bolt C: 14 mm (0.551in.)
9.
INSTALL OIL STRAINER AND CHECK VALVE
Install the oil strainer and check valve into the lower valve
body.
AX–84
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
10. INSTALL LOWER VALVE BODY COVER GASKETS
AND NO.2 PLATE
Position a new gasket and plate and then another new
gasket.
HINT: Both gaskets are identical.
11. INSTALL LOWER VALVE BODY COVER
(a) Position the lower valve body cover.
(b) Install and finger tighten the 5 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length
Bolt A: 47 mm (1.850 in.)
Bolt B: 14 mm (0.551 in.)
12. INSTALL PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
13. TIGHTEN BOLTS OF UPPER AND LOWER VALVE BODIES
(a) Tighten the 16 bolts in the lower valve body.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
(b) Tighten the 3 bolts in the upper valve body.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
14. INSTALL B0 ACCUMULATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Coat new O–rings with ATF and install them to the piston.
(b) Install the spring and piston into the cylinder.
Spring dimensions
mm (in.)
Color
Free length
Coil outer diameter
Inner
White
47.5 (1.870)
18.9 (0.744)
Outer
None
16.3 (0.642)
20.7 (0.815)
AX–85
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
VALVE BODY
(d) Install the B0 accumulator assembly.
(e) Install the torque the 3 bolts.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
15. INSTALL LOCK PLATE
16. INSTALL SOLENOIDS
(a) Coat new O–rings with ATF and install them to the solenoids.
(b) Install the lock–up solenoid.
(c) Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
(d) Install the No.4 solenoid.
(e) Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
(d) Install No.1 and No.2 solenoids.
(e) Install and torque the 3 bolts.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
AX–86
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX047–03
COMPONENTS
AX–87
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX048–03
VALVE BODY SPRINGS SPECIFICATIONS
HINT: During reassembly please refer to the spring specifications above to help discriminate between
the different springs.
Mar
k
Name (Color)
Free Length / Outer Diameter
mm (in.)
Total No. of Coils
@@
@@
@:
Lock–Up Relay Valve (Yellow)
26.8 (1.055) / 10.2 (0.402)
10.8
B1 Orifice Control Valve (White)
24.8 (0.976) / 6.4 (0.252)
12.0
Throttle Valve (Green)
31.5 (1.240) / 7.0 (0.276)
11.4
Down–Shift Plug (None)
15.0 (0.591) / 11.0 (0.433)
7.0
[c A]
@@
@@
@:
[c B]
@@
@@
@:
[c C]
@@
@@
@:
[c D]
AX–88
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
@@
@@
@:
[c E]
Low Coast Modulator Valve (Purple)
20.2 (0.795) / 7.9 (0.311)
11.9
AX–89
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
UPPER VALVE BODY
AX0GZ–02
RETAINERS, PIN, AND CHECK BALLS LOCATION
1.
PIN, RETAINERS
Mark
Name
Height / Width / Thickness
mm (in.)
@@@@@: [c A]
B1 Orifice Control Valve
8.9 (0.350) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c B]
Low Coast Modulator Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
2.
CHECK BALLS
AX–90
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX04A–03
COMPONENTS
AX–91
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX04B–03
VALVE BODY SPRINGS SPECIFICATIONS
HINT: During reassembly please refer to the spring specifications above to help discriminate between
the different springs.
Mar
k
Name (Color)
Free Length / Outer Diameter
mm (in.)
Total No. of Coils
@@
@@
@:
Accumulator Control Valve (Red)
25.1 (0.988) / 8.6 (0.339)
8.0
2–3 Shift Valve (None)
28.0 (1.102) / 7.6 (0.299)
10.3
1–2 Shift Valve (Light Green)
29.2 (1.150) / 8.9 (0.350)
12.0
Reverse Control Valve (White/Purple)
38.1 (1.500) / 6.5 (0.256)
19.0
[c A]
@@
@@
@:
[c B]
@@
@@
@:
[c C]
@@
@@
@:
[c D]
AX–92
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
@@
@@
@:
Cut–Back Valve (None)
21.8 (0.858) / 6.0 (0.236)
13.5
Primary Regulator Valve (None)
36.6 (1.441) / 16.1 (0.634)
6.3
3–4 Shift Valve (None)
28.0 (1.102) / 7.6 (0.299)
10.3
Second Lock Valve (None)
20.7 (0.815) / 7.4 (0.291)
9.5
Second Coast Modulator Valve (White)
32.2 (1.268) / 9.0 (0.354)
11.4
Solenoid Modulator Valve (Purple/Pink)
30.2 (1.189) / 5.6 (0.220)
15.3
Secondary Regulator Valve (None)
46.9 (1.846) / 5.9 (0.232)
21.8
[c E]
@@
@@
@:
[c F]
@@
@@
@:
[c G]
@@
@@
@:
[c H]
@@
@@
@:
[c I]
@@
@@
@:
[c J]
@@
@@
@:
[c K]
AX–93
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX0TY–01
RETAINERS AND CHECK BALLS LOCATION
1.
RETAINERS
Mark
Name
Height / Width / Thickness mm (in.)
@@@@@: [c A]
Accumulator Control Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c B]
2–3 Shift Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c C]
1–2 Shift Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c D]
Reverse Control Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c E]
Cut–Back Valve
6.5 (0.256) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c F]
Secondary Regulator Valve
11.0 (0.433) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c G]
Solenoid Modulator Valve
8.5 (0.335) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c H]
Lock–Up Control Valve
9.2 (0.362) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c I]
Second Coast Modulator Valve
8.0 (0.315) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c J]
Second Lock Valve
9.2 (0.362) / 11.5 (0.453) / 3.2 (0.126)
@@@@@: [c K]
3–4 Shift Valve
6.5 (0.256) / 5.0 (0.197) / 3.2 (0.126)
2.
CHECK BALLS
Upper Side
AX–94
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Lower Side
–
LOWER VALVE BODY
AX–95
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
AX04D–02
COMPONENTS
AX–96
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
AX0TZ–02
DIFFERENTIAL CASE DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SIDE BEARING
Using SST, remove the 2 side bearings.
SST 09608–16011, 09550–40010
2. REMOVE RING GEAR
(a) Place matchmarks on both the differential case and ring
gear.
(b) Remove the 12 bolts.
(c)
Using a plastic hammer, tap out the ring gear.
3.
CHECK SIDE GEAR BACKLASH
Using a dial gauge, measure the backlash of each side
gear while holding one pinion toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
AX–97
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
4. DISASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Drive out the pinion shaft lock pin from the side on which
the ring gear is installed.
(b) Remove the pinion shaft from the case.
(c) Remove the 2 pinions and side gears with the 4 thrust
washers.
AX0U0–02
DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
1. ASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Install the removed thrust washers to the side gears.
(b) Install the side gears with thrust washers, pinion thrust
washers and pinion gears.
(c)
Install the pinion shaft.
AX–98
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
(d) Check the side gear backlash.
Measure the side gear backlash while holding one pinion
gear toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05–0.20 mm (0.0020–0.0079 in.)
Refering to the table below, select thrust washers which
will ensure that the backlash is within specification. Try to
select washers of the same size for both sides.
Thrust washer thickness
mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
1.60 (0.0630)
1.70 (0.0670)
1.80 (0.0709)
If the backlash is not within specification, install a thrust
washer of a different thickness.
(e) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive the lock pin through
the case and hole in the pinion shaft.
(f) Stake the differential case.
2. INSTALL RING GEAR
(a) Clean the contact surface of the differential case.
(b) Heat the ring gear to about 100°C (212°F) in an oil bath.
NOTICE: Do not heat the ring gear above 110°C (230°F).
(c) Carefully remove the ring gear from the oil bath.
(d) Clean the contact surface of the ring gear with cleaning
solvent.
(e) Quickly install the ring gear on the differential case.
Install the 12 bolts.
HINT: Align the matchmarks on the differential left case
and contact the ring gear.
(f) Tighten the set bolts uniformly a little at a time.
Torque the bolts.
Torque: 124 N·m (1,260 kgf·cm, 91 ft·lbf)
AX–99
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
3. INSTALL SIDE BEARING
(a) Install the speedometer drive gear onto the differential
case.
(b) Using SST and a press, press in the RH side bearing onto
the differential case.
SST 09316–20011
(c)
Using SST and a press, press in the LH side bearing onto
the differential case.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00010)
AX–100
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
AX04G–06
Disassembly, inspection and assembly of each component group have been indicated in the preceding
chapter. Before assembly, make sure, again, that all component groups are assembled correctly.
If something wrong is found in a certain component group during assembly, inspect and repair this group
immediately.
Recommended ATF: D–@@@@@: [g 2] or DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 3](DEXRON®@@@@@: [g 2])
AX04H–03
GENERAL INSTALLATION NOTES:
(a) The automatic transaxle is composed of highly precision–finished parts, necessitating careful inspection before assembly because even a small nick could cause fluid leakage or affect performance.
(b) Before assembling new clutch discs, soak them in automatic transaxle fluid for at least 15 minutes.
(c) Apply automatic transaxle fluid on the sliding or rotating surfaces of parts before assembly.
(d) Use petroleum jelly to keep small parts in their places.
(e) Do not use adhesive cements on gaskets and similar parts.
(f) When assembling the transaxle, be sure to use new gaskets and O–rings.
(g) Dry all parts with compressed air–never use shop rags.
(h) Be sure to install the thrust bearings and races in the correct direction and position.
AX–101
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Mark
Thrust Bearing Outside Diameter
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
Thrust Bearing Inside Diameter
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
A
See page AX–118
27.7 (1.091)
B
47.6 (1.874)
31.4 (1.236)
C
45.5 (1.791)
30.1 (1.185)
D
45.5 (1.791)
30.1 (1.185)
E
38.7 (1.524)
22.6 (0.890)
F
46.3 (1.823)
28.6 (1.126)
AX–102
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
AX0U1–02
DIFFERENTIAL AND DRIVE PINION
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL DRIVE PINION INTO TRANSAXLE CASE
(a) Using SST, install the bearing to the drive pinion shaft.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32120)
(b) Place the bearing cage onto the drive pinion shaft.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seals with the
pinion shaft.
(c)
Using a brass bar and hammer, slightly tap the bearing
cage into the transaxle case until the snap ring groove in
the bore can be seen.
(d) Using SST, install snap ring into the bore.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(e) Using SST, install the snap ring.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
AX–103
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
2.
PLACE OIL SLINGER AND NEW SPACER
HINT: Install the spacer with the small end downward.
3.
INSTALL OUTER RACE TO TRANSAXLE CASE
Using SST, press in the outer race.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32100, 09351–32140)
4. INSTALL COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
(a) Place a brass bar into the transaxle hole to hold the drive
pinion shaft.
(b) Using SST, press in the counter driven gear until the
counter driven gaer bearing almost touches the counter
gear.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32140)
5.
INSTALL NEW LOCK NUT AND ADJUST DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
(a) Install the new lock nut.
(b) Using SST to hold the gear, tighten the nut.
Torque: 280 N·m (2,855 kgf·cm, 206 ft·lbf)
SST 09330–00021, 09350–32014 (09351–32032)
Turn the gear counterclockwise and clockwise several
times.
(d) Using a small torque wrench, measure the preload of the
drive pinion.
(c)
Drive pinion preload (at starting):
New bearing
1.0–1.6 N·m (10–16 kgf·cm, 8.7–13.9 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing
0.5–0.8 N·m (5–8 kgf·cm, 4.3–6.9 in.·lbf)
If the preload is greater than specified, replace the
bearing spacer.
AX–104
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
If the preload is less then specified, retighten the nut
13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf) at a time until the specified preload is reached.
If the maximum torque is exceeded while retightening the
nut, replace the bearing spacer and repeat the preload
procedure.
Do not back off the nut to reduce the preload.
Maximum torque: 353 N·m (3,600 kgf·cm, 260 ft·lbf)
(e) If the preload is adjusted within specification, make a note
of it.
(f) Stroke the lock nut.
6.
INSTALL APPLY GASKET
7.
PLACE OUTER RACE AND SHIM ONTO RH SIDE
BEARING
8.
PLACE DIFFERENTIAL CASE INTO TRANSAXLE
CASE
Be sure to install the shim and outer race into place.
AX–105
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
9. INSTALL CARRIER COVER
(a) Remove any packing material and be careful not to drop
oil on the contacting surfaces of the carrier cover and
transaxle case.
(b) Apply seal packing to the carrier cover.
Seal packing:
Part No.08826–00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
(c)
HINT: Install the carrier cover within 10 minutes after applying seal packing.
Install and torque the 11 bolts.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 100 mm (3.937 in.)
Bolt B: 65 mm (2.559 in.)
Bolt C: 75 mm (2.953 in.)
10. ADJUST SIDE BEARING PRELOAD
(a) Remove any packing material on the contacting surfaces
of the LH bearing retainer and transaxle case.
HINT: Do not apply seal packing yet.
(b) Install the LH bearing retainer and torque the 6 bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(c)
Snap down the bearings by turning the differential case
several times.
(d) Using a small torque wrench, measure the differential total preload.
Total preload (at starting):
New bearing
Drive pinion preload plus 0.2–0.4 N·m
(2.5–5.1 kgf·cm, 2.2–3.6 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing
Drive pinion preload plus 0.1–0.2 N·m
(1.3–2.0 kgf·cm, 1.1–1.7 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within specification, replace the adjusting shim in the LH bearing retainer with one of a different thickness.
AX–106
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
AT3700:Adjusting shim thickness
mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness
Mark
Thickness
0
2.00 (0.0787)
9
2.45 (0.0965)
1
2.05 (0.0807)
A
2.50 (0.0984)
2
2.10 (0.0827)
B
2.55 (0.1004)
3
2.15 (0.0846)
C
2.60 (0.1024)
4
2.20 (0.0866)
D
2.65 (0.1043)
5
2.25 (0.0886)
E
2.70 (0.1063)
6
2.30 (0.0906)
F
2.75 (0.1083)
7
2.35 (0.0925)
G
2.80 (0.1102)
8
2.40 (0.0945)
H
2.85 (0.1122)
11. INSTALL LH BEARING RETAINER
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and LH bearing retainer.
(b) Remove any FIPG material on the contacting surfaces of
LH bearing retainer, transaxle case and carrier cover.
(c) Apply FIPG to the transaxle case and carrier cover.
FIPG: Part No.08826–00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
HINT: Install the LH bearing retainer within 10 minutes after applying FIPG.
(d) Install the LH bearing retainer.
(e) Coat the threads of bolts with sealer.
Sealer: Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(f)
Tighten the bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(g) Snap down the bearings.
(h) Recheck the differential total preload.
AX–107
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
12. INSTALL NEW OIL SEAL
(a) Place the oil baffle onto the LH bearing retainer.
(b) Using SST, drive in a new oil seal unit its end is flush with
surface of the LH bearing retainer.
SST 09223–15010
13. INSTALL RH RETAINER
(a) Remove any FIPG material on the contacting surfaces of
RH retainer and transaxle case.
(b) Apply FIPG to the RH retainer.
FIPG: Part No.08826–00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
HINT: Install the RH retainer within 10 minutes after applying FIPG.
(c)
Coat the bolts’ threads with sealer.
Sealer: Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(d) Tighten the bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(e) Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09226–10010
AX–108
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
14. INSTALL DRIVE PINION CAP
(a) Install a new O–ring to the cap.
(b) Install the drive pinion cap to the transaxle case.
AX0U2–03
4–SPEED GEAR UNIT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL PARKING LOCK PAWL
(a) Place the parking lock pawl onto the case.
Hook the spring ends to the case and pawl.
(b) Instal the pin into the hole of the case through the spring
and pawl.
2. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE SHAFT
(a) Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
(b) Install the manual valve shaft oil seal to the case.
(c)
Assembly a new collar to the manual valve lever.
(d) Install the manual valve shaft to the transmission case
through the manual lever.
(e) Install the parking lock rod.
AX–109
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(f)
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
Using a pin punch, drive in the roll pin until its surface is
flush with the manual valve lever surface.
(g) Match the collar hole to the lever caulking hollow and
caulk the collar to the lever.
(h) Install the retaining spring.
3.
INSTALL PARKING LOCK PAWL BRACKET AND
GUIDE
Torque: 7.4 N·m (75 kgf·cm, 65 in.·lbf)
4.
CHECK OPERATION OF PARKING LOCK PAWL
Make sure the counter driven gear is locked when the
manual valve lever is in the P position.
AX–110
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
5.
INSTALL FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE PISTON TO
TRANSMISSION CASE
(a) Coat the new O–rings with ATF.
(b) Install the 2 O–rings on the piston.
(c)
Push the piston into the bore of the case, facing the spring
seat upward.
6. INSTALL PISTON RETURN SPRING
(a) Place the return spring and snap ring on the piston.
(b) Place SST, and compress the return spring evenly by
tightening the bolt gradually.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32040)
(c)
Install snap ring. Visually check to make sure it is fully
seated and centered by the 3 lugs on the spring retainer.
Be sure the end gap of snap ring is not aligned with the
spring retainer claw.
(d) Remove the SST.
7.
INSTALL SNAP RING TO TRANSAXLE CASE
AX–111
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
8. INSTALL OVERDRIVE UNIT
(a) Install the overdrive brake apply gasket and overdrive
clutch apply gasket.
(b) Install the overdrive brake drum to the case.
(c) Install the new case gasket to the case.
(d) Make sure that the length from the top surface of the case
to the counter driven gear surface should be about 24 mm
(0.94 in.).
(e) Place the new gasket onto the transaxle case.
(f) Install the overdrive assembly with overdrive case to the
transaxle case.
AX–112
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(g) Coat the threads of 23 mm (0.91 in.) bolts with sealer.
Sealer:
Part No.08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(h) Install and tighten the 13 bolts.
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 61 mm (2.402 in.)
Bolt B 38 mm (1.496 in.)
Bolt C: 23 mm (0.906 in.)
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
9. CHECK INTERMEDIATE SHAFT END PLAY
(a) Make sure that the intermediate shaft as end play in axial
direction.
End play: 0.47–1.50 mm (0.0185–0.0591 in.)
If the end play is not within specification, check the installation of intermediate shaft.
(b) Make sure that the intermediate shaft turns smoothly.
10. INSTALL REAR PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Install the rear planetary ring gear.
(b) Place the bearing onto the ring gear.
Bearing outer diameter: 38.7 mm (1.524 in.)
Bearing inner diameter: 22.6 mm (0.890 in.)
(c)
Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and place it
onto the rear planetary gear.
AX–113
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(d) Install the rear planetary gear.
11. INSTALL DISCS, PLATES AND FLANGE OF FIRST
AND REVERSE BRAKE
(a) Install the 6 plates and discs.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D–P–D
(b) Install the flange, facing the flat end downward.
(c)
Install the snap ring.
HINT: Be sure that the end gap of the snap ring is not
aligned with one of the cutouts.
12. CHECK FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE
(a) Check the operation of the first and reverse brake piston.
Apply compressed air into the case passage and confirm
that the piston moves.
(b) Using a filler gauge, check that pack clearance of the first
and reverse brake.
Clearance:
1.92–2.68 mm (0.0756–0.1055 in.)
AX–114
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
13. INSTALL NO.2 ONE–WAY CLUTCH INTO CASE
(a) Place the No.2 one–way clutch with the shiny side of
flange upward.
(b) Install the one–way clutch while turning the planetary
gear clockwise with SST.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
If the planetary gear cannot turn clockwise, check the
installation of the one–way clutch.
(c)
Install the snap ring.
HINT: Be sure that the end gap of the snap ring is not
aligned with one of cutouts.
(d) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
onto the rear planetary gear.
14. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND GUIDE
15. PLACE NO.1 ONE–WAY CLUTCH
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
on the No.1 one–way clutch.
AX–115
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Place the No.1 one–way clutch onto the rear planetary
gear.
16. INSTALL SECOND BRAKE
(a) Install the flange, facing the flat end upward.
(b) Install the 3 discs and plates.
Install in order:
P=Plate D=Disc
D–P–D–P–D–P
(c)
Place the piston return spring into the case.
(d) Place the second brake drum into the case.
HINT: Align the groove of the drum with the bolt.
(e) Place the snap ring into the case so that end gap is
installed into the groove.
(f) While compressing the piston return spring over the drum
with screwdriver, install the snap ring into the groove.
(g) Be sure that the end gap of the snap ring is not aligned
with one of cutouts.
AX–116
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
17. INSTALL NEW SECOND BRAKE GASKET
Install a new gasket until it makes contact with the second
brake drum.
18. CHECK OPERATION OF SECOND BRAKE
Apply compressed air into the second brake gasket and
confirm that the piston moves.
19. INSTALL SUN GEAR AND SUN GEAR INPUT DRUM
(a) Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
on the sun gear input drum.
(b) While turning the sun gear clockwise, install it into the
No.1 one–way clutch.
20. INSTALL OIL SEAL RING TO INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
HINT: After installing the oil seal ring, check that it moves
smoothly.
AX–117
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
21. INSTALL FRONT PLANETARY GEAR
(a) Coat the bearings with petroleum jelly, and install them
onto the both sides of planetary gear.
Bearing outer diameter: 45.5 mm (1.791 in.)
Bearing inner diameter: 30.1 mm (1.185 in.)
(b) Install the planetary gear onto the sun gear.
22. INSTALL FRONT PLANETARY RING GEAR
23. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE BAND
(a) Place the band into the case.
(b) Install the pin through the oil pump mounting bolt hole.
24. INSTALL FORWARD CLUTCH AND DIRECT CLUTCH
(a) Coat the bearing with petroleum jelly and install it onto
rear side of the forward clutch.
Bearing outer diameter: 47.6 mm (1.874 in.)
Bearing inner diameter: 31.4 mm (1.236 in.)
AX–118
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Coat the bearing with petroleum jelly and install it onto the
front side of the forward clutch.
HINT: There are 2 different thickness bearings for adjustment of the input shaft thrust play.
Bearing thickness
mm (in.)
(c)
Thickness
Outer diameter
Inner diameter
3.60 (0.1417)
45.9 (1.807)
27.7 (1.091)
4.19 (0.1650)
47.1 (1.854)
27.7 (1.091)
Coat the thrust washer with petroleum jelly and install it
with the oil groove facing upward onto the direct clutch
drum.
(d) Mesh the hub of the forward clutch flukes with the direct
clutch discs.
HINT: Be careful that the bearing and thrust washer do not
get out of place.
(e) Install the direct clutch and forward clutch into the case.
HINT: Hold the direct clutch toward the forward clutch to
prevent the thrust washer from getting out of place.
25. INSTALL OIL PUMP INTO CASE
(a) Coat a new O–ring with ATF and install it to the oil pump.
AX–119
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Place the oil pump through the input shaft, and align the
bolt holes of the pump body with the transmission case.
NOTICE: Do not push on the oil pump strongly or the oil
seal ring will stick to the direct clutch drum.
Torque: 22 N·m (225 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
26. MEASURE END PLAY OF INPUT SHAFT
Measure the end play with a dial gauge.
End play:
0.25–0.90 mm (0.0098–0.0354 in.)
HINT: There are 2 different thickness bearings for end of
stator shaft. If the end play is in excess of standard, select
one of them.
Bearing thickness:
3.60 mm (0.1417 in.)
4.19 mm (0.1650 in.)
27. CHECK INPUT SHAFT ROTATION
Make sure that the input shaft rotates smoothly.
28. INSTALL SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON
(a) Coat the new O–rings with ATF and install it to the cover.
(b) Install the outer spring with the piston.
(c) Place the cover into the bore.
(d) Using SST, install the snap ring while pressing the cover.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32050)
(e) Check that the front end of the piston rod contacts the
center of the second brake band depression.
29. CHECK SECOND COAST BRAKE PISTON STROKE
(a) Apply a small amount of paint to the piston rod at the point
it meets the case.
AX–120
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
(b) Using SST, measure the piston stroke while applying and
releasing compressed air (392–785 kPa, 4–8 kgf/cm2,
57–114 psi).
SST 09240–00020
Piston stroke:
2.0–3.5 mm (0.079–0.138 in.)
If the stroke is more than specified, replace the piston rod
with a longer one.
Piston rod length:
95.2 mm (3.748 in.)
96.3 mm (3.791 in.)
If the still more than standard value, replace the brake
band with a new one.
AX0U3–02
HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL ACCUMULATOR PISTONS AND SPRINGS
(a) Install the new O–rings to the pistons.
(b) Install the springs and pistons into the bores.
Spring dimensions
mm (in.)
Spring
Color
Free length
C2
Yellow/Purple
51.8 (2.039)
B2
None
88.2 (3.473)
B2
None
70.3 (2.767)
C1
None
73.6 (2.898)
(c)
Place the cover with a new gasket and gradually tighten
the bolts a little at a time in sequence.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
AX–121
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
2.
PLACE NEW SECOND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
3.
INSTALL SOLENOID WIRE
4.
INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE
5. INSTALL VALVE BODY TO TRANSAXLE CASE
(a) While holding the cam down with your hand, slip the cable
end into the slot.
(b) Lower the valve body into place.
NOTICE: Do not entangle the solenoid wire.
AX–122
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
(c)
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
Install and tighten the 9 bolts.
HINT:
Each bolt length is indicated below.
Hand tighten the 9 bolts first, then torque with a
torque wrench.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 30 mm (1.181 in.)
Bolt B: 43 mm (1.693 in.)
Bolt C: 48 mm (1.890 in.)
Bolt D: 52 mm (2.047 in.)
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
6.
INSTALL B3 APPLY PIPE
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the pipe.
7.
INSTALL CONNECTOR CLAMP AND PIPE RETAINER
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 48 mm (1.890 in.)
Bolt B: 39 mm (1.535 in.)
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
8.
CONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
AX–123
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
9.
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
INSTALL OIL PIPES
Using a plastic hammer, install the pipes into the positions.
NOTICE: Be careful not to bend or damage the pipes.
10. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE BODY AND DETENT
SPRING
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 22 mm (0.866 in.)
Bolt B: 37 mm (1.457 in.)
(a) Align the manual valve with the pin on the manual shaft
lever.
(b) Lower the manual valve body into place.
(c) Hand tighten the 5 bolts first. Then, tighten them with a
torque wrench.
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
(d) Place the detent springs on the manual valve body and
hand tighten the 2 bolts first.
Then, tighten them with a torque wrench.
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 14 mm (0.551 in.)
Bolt B: 37 mm (1.457 in.)
(e) Check that the manual valve lever is touching the center
of the detent spring tip roller.
11. INSTALL PIPE BRACKET AND OIL STRAINER
Each bolt length is indicated below.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 22 mm (0.866 in.)
Bolt B: 53 mm (2.087 in.)
Torque:
Pipe bracket: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Oil strainer: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
AX–124
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
12. INSTALL MAGNETS IN PLACE
NOTICE: Make sure that the magnets do not interfere with
the oil pipes.
13. INSTALL OIL PAN WITH NEW GASKET
(a) Install a new gasket and oil pan.
(b) Install and torque the 17 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 43 in.·lbf)
14. INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE RETAINING PLATE
15. INSTALL TRANSAXLE UPPER COVER
16. INSTALL T/M REVOLUTION SENSOR
(a) Install a new O–ring to the T/M revolution sensor.
(b) Install the T/M revolution sensor with the bolt.
AX–125
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
17. INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(a) Install the park/neutral position switch to the manual valve
shaft.
(b) Place the new locking plate and tighten the nut.
(c) Stake the nut with locking plate.
(d) Install the 2 bolts.
(e) Adjust the park/neutral position switch.
HINT: Align the groove and neutral basic line.
(f) Tighten the 2 bolts.
18. INSTALL UNION AND ELBOW
(a) Install the new O–rings to the union and elbow.
(b) Install the union elbow to the transaxle case.
Torque: 27 N·m (275 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
HINT: Install the elbow, as shown in the illustration.
19. INSTALL MANUAL SHAFT LEVER
AX–126
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
COMPONENT PARTS INSTALLATION
20. INSTALL SHIFT CONTROL CABLE BRACKET
AX–127
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
AX0H1–06
SERVICE DATE
Second Coast Brake
2.0 – 3.5 mm
Piston stroke
0.079 – 0.138 in.
95.2 mm
Piston rod length
3.748 in.
96.3 mm
3.791 in.
Oil Pump
Body clearance
STD
Maximum
Tip clearance
STD
Maximum
Side clearance
STD
Maximum
Pump body bushing inside diameter
Maximum
0.07 – 0.15 mm
0.0028 – 0.0059 in.
0.30 mm
0.0118 in.
0.11 – 0.14 mm
0.0043 – 0.0055 in.
0.30 mm
0.0118 in.
0.02 – 0.05 mm
0.0008 – 0.0020 in.
0.10 mm
0.0039 in.
38.18 mm
1.5031 in.
Stator shaft bushing inside diameter
Front side
Maximum
Rear side
Maximum
21.57 mm
0.8492 in.
27.07 mm
1.0657 in.
Direct Clutch
Piston stroke
Drum bushing inside diameter
0.91 – 1.35 mm
0.0358 – 0.0531 in.
48.27 mm
1.9004 in.
2.70 mm
Flange thickness
0.1063 in.
3.00 mm
0.1181 in.
Forward Clutch
Piston stroke
1.79 – 2.21 mm
0.0704 – 0.0870 in.
2.30 mm
Flange thickness
0.0906 in.
2.70 mm
0.1063 in.
AX–128
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Front Planetary Gear
Sun gear bushing inside diameter
Maximum
Ring gear flange bushing inside diameter
Maximum
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
Maximum
22.59 mm
0.8894 in.
30.08 mm
1.1842 in.
0.61 mm
0.024 in.
Rear Planetary Gear
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
Maximum
0.61 mm
0.024 in.
First and Reverse Brake
1.92 – 2.68 mm
Pack clearance
0.0756 – 0.1055 in.
Overdrive Unit
1.75 – 2.49 mm
Piston stroke
Direct clutch bushing inside diameter
0.0689 – 0.0980 in.
Maximum
22.13 mm
0.8713 in.
0.16 – 0.56 mm
Planetary pinion gear thrust clearance
STD 0.0063 – 0.0220 in.
Maximum
0.61 mm
0.024 in.
AX–129
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Valve Body Spring
Free length / Coil outer diameter
Spring
Total No. of coils / Color
mm (in.)
Upper valve body
Low coast modulator valve
20.2 (0.795) / 7.9 (0.311)
11.9 / Purple
B1 orifice control valve
24.8 (0.976) / 6.4 (0.252)
12.0 / White
Down–shift plug
15.0 (0.591) / 11.0 (0.433)
7.0 / None
Throttle valve
31.5 (1.240) / 7.0 (0.276)
11.4 / Green
Lock–up relay valve
26.8 (1.055) / 10.2 (0.402)
10.8 / Yellow
2–3 shift valve
28.0 (1.102) / 9.4 (0.370)
10.3 / None
Second coast modulator valve
20.2 (0.795) / 7.9 (0.311)
11.9 / Purple
Lower valve body
Accumulator control vavle
25.1 (0.988) / 8.6 (0.339)
8.0 / Red
Secondary regulator valve
46.9 (1.846) / 5.9 (0.232)
21.8 / None
Second lock valve
20.7 (0.815) / 7.4 (0.291)
9.5 / None
Reverse control valve
38.1 (1.500) / 6.5 (0.256)
19.0 / White/Purple
1–2 shift valve
29.2 (1.150) / 8.9 (0.350)
12.0 / Light Green
3–4 shift valve
28.0 (1.102) / 7.6 (0.299)
10.3 / None
Primary regulator valve
36.6 (1.441) / 16.1 (0.634)
6.3 / None
Cut–back valve
21.8 (0.858) / 6.0 (0.236)
13.5 / None
Solenoid modulator valve
30.2 (1.189) / 5.6 (0.220)
15.3 / Purple/Pink
Valve Body Key
Height
Width
Thickness
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
mm (in.)
B1 orifice control valve
8.9 (0.350)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Low coast modulator valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Accumulator control valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Secondary regulator valve
11.0 (0.433)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
1–2 shift valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
2–3 shift valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
3–4 shift valve
6.5 (0.256)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Key
Upper valve body
Lower valve body
Second lock valve
9.2 (0.362)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Second coast modulator valve
8.0 (0.315)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Reverse control valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Cut–back valve
9.2 (0.362)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Solenoid modulator valve
8.5 (0.335)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
Lock–up control valve
9.2 (0.315)
5.0 (0.197)
3.2 (0.126)
AX–130
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Accumulator Spring
Spring
C0
Free length mm (in.)
Color
Inner
47.5 (1.870)
White
Outer
16.3 (0.642)
None
C1
73.6 (2.898)
None
C2
51.8 (2.039)
Yellow / Purple
B0
66.8 (2.630)
Red / Yellow
Inner
70.3 (2.767)
None
Outer
88.2 (3.473)
None
B2
Differential Assembly
Drive pinion preload (at Starting)
New bearing
Reused bearing
1.0 – 1.6 N·m
10 – 16 kgf·cm
8.7 – 13.9 in.·lbf
0.5 – 0.8 N·m
5 – 8 kgf·cm
4.3 – 6.9 in.·lbf
Total preload (at starting)
New bearing
Reused bearing
Pinion to side gear backlash
Drive pinion preload plus 0.3 – 0.4 N·m
2.8 – 4.4 kgf·cm 2.4 – 3.8 in.·lbf
Drive pinion preload plus 0.1 – 0.2 N·m
1.4 – 2.2 kgf·cm 1.2 – 1.9 in.·lbf
0.05 – 0.20 mm
0.0020 – 0.0079 in.
1.60 mm
Side gear thrust washer thickness
0.0630 in.
1.70 mm
0.0670 in.
1.80 mm
0.0709 in.
AX–131
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
2.00 mm
0.0787 in.
2.05 mm
0.0807 in.
2.10 mm
0.0827 in.
2.15 mm
0.0846 in.
Side bearing adjusting shim thickness
Mark
2.20 mm
0 0.0866 in.
1
2.25 mm
2 0.0886 in.
3
2.30 mm
4 0.0906 in.
5
2.35 mm
6 0.0925 in.
7
2.40 mm
8 0.0945 in.
9
2.45 mm
A 0.0965 in.
B
2.50 mm
C 0.0984 in.
D
2.55 mm
E 0.1004 in.
2.60 mm
F
G 0.1024 in.
2.65 mm
H
0.1043 in.
2.70 mm
0.1063 in.
2.75 mm
0.1083 in.
2.80 mm
0.1102 in.
2.85 mm
0.1122 in.
AX–132
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
–
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
AX04N–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Oil cooler pipe union
27
275
20
Oil pan
4.9
50
43 in.·lbf
Valve body x Transaxle case
11
110
8
Accumulator x Cover
10
100
7
Oil pump x Transaxle case
22
225
16
O/D case x Transaxle case
25
250
18
Differential LH side bearing retainer
19
195
14
Differential RH retainer
19
195
14
Differential carrier cover
39
400
29
Oil pump body x Stator shaft
10
100
7
Ring gear x Differential case
124
1,260
91
Upper valve body x Lower valve body
6.6
67
58 in.·lbf
Accumulator cylinder x Valve body
6.6
67
58 in.·lbf
Solenoid x Valve body
6.6
67
58 in.·lbf
Counter drive gear lock nut
280
2,855
206
Carrire cover x Transaxle case
39
400
29
Parking lock pawl bracket
7.4
75
65 in.·lbf
Oil strainer x Transaxle case
11
110
8
PP–1
PREPARATION
–
MAINTENANCE
MAINTENANCE
PP0E6–01
EQUIPMENT
Mirror
Brake hose
Torque wrench
Author:
Date:
53
PP–2
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
PP0JQ–04
SST (Special Service Tools)
09201–10000
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer Set
(09201–01060)
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer 6
09201–41020
Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer
09202–70020
Valve Spring Compressor
(09202–00010)
09213–54015
(91651–60855)
Attachment
Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
Bolt
Crankshaft pulley (Type A)
09222–30010
Connecting Rod Bushing Remover
& Replacer
09223–15030
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
Crankshaft rear oil seal
09223–46011
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
Camshaft oil seal
09224–74010
Engine Balancer Backlash
Adjusting Tool
09226–10010
Crankshaft Front & Rear Bearing
Replacer
Author:
Crankshaft front oil seal
Date:
54
PP–3
PREPARATION
09248–55040
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
Valve Clearance Adjust Tool Set
(09248–05410)
Valve Lifter Press
(09248–05420)
Valve Lifter Stopper
09249–63010
Torque Wrench Adaptor
Camshaft timing pulley
09330–00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
Crankshaft pulley
09612–24014
Steering Gear Housing Overhaul
Tool Set
(09617–24011)
Steering Rack Wrench
Fuel inlet hose
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
09950–50012
Puller C Set
(09951–05010)
Hanger 150
Crankshaft pulley
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09952–05010)
Slide Arm
Crankshaft pulley
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09953–05010)
Center Bolt 100
Crankshaft pulley
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09953–05020)
Center Bolt 150
Crankshaft pulley
Crankshaft timing pulley
Author:
Date:
55
PP–4
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(09954–05010)
Claw No.1
Crankshaft pulley (Type B)
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09954–05020)
Claw No.2
Crankshaft pulley (Type A)
09950–70010
Handle Set
(09951–07100)
Handle 100
09960–10010
Valve guide bushing
Crankshaft rear oil seal
Variable Pin Wrench Set
(09962–01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
Camshaft timing pulley
Oil pump pulley
Camshaft sub–gear gear
(09963–00500)
Pin 5
Oil pump pulley
Camshaft sub–gear gear
(09963–01000)
Pin 10
Camshaft timing pulley
Author:
Date:
56
PP–5
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
PP0JR–04
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09090–04020
Engine Sling Device
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
09258–00030
Hose Plug Set .
09904–00010
Expander Set .
For suspending engine
Plug for vacuum hose, fuel hose
etc.
Author:
Date:
57
PP–6
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
PP0JS–04
EQUIPMENT
Abrasive compound
Valve
Caliper gauge
CO/HC meter
Compression gauge
Connecting aligner
Cylinder gauge
Dial indicator
Dye penetrant
Engine tune–up tester
Groove cleaning tool
Piston ring groove
Heater
Magnetic finger
Micrometer
OBDII scan tool
Pin hole grinder
Piston pin hole of piston
Piston ring compressor
Piston ring expander
Plastigage
Precision straight edge
Press
Ridge reamer
Cylinder
Soft brush
Solvent
Spring tester
Valve spring
Steel square
Valve spring
Thermometer
Torque wrench
Valve seat cutter
V–block
Vernier calipers
Wire brush
Valve
Author:
Date:
58
PP–7
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
PP1WA–02
SSM (Special Service Materials)
08826–00080
Seal Packing Black or equivalent
(FIPG)
Camshaft bearing cap
Cylinder head cover
Semi–circular plug
08833–00070
Adhesive 1324,
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Flywheel or drive plate bolt
Torque converter clutch bolt
08833–00080
Adhesive 1344
THREE BOND 1344
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Oil pressure switch
Author:
Date:
59
PP–8
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
PP0BR–03
SST (Special Service Tools)
09201–01055
Valve Guide Bushing Remover & Re
placer 5.5
09201–41020
Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer
09202–70020
Valve Spring Compressor
(09202–00010)
09213–54015
(91651–60855)
Attachment
Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
Bolt
09222–30010
Connecting Rod Bushing Remover
& Replacer
09223–15030
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
09248–55040
Valve Clearance Adjust Tool Set
(09248–05410)
Valve Lifter Press
(09248–05420)
Valve Lifter Stopper
09249–63010
Torque Wrench Adaptor
Crankshaft rear oil seal
RH camshaft timing pulley
Author:
Date:
60
PP–9
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
09330–00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
Crankshaft pulley
09608–03071
Replacer
Spark plug tube gasket
09816–30010
Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Knock sensor
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
09950–50012
Puller C Set
(09951–05010)
Hanger 150
Crankshaft pulley
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09952–05010)
Slide Arm
Crankshaft pulley
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09953–05010)
Center Bolt 100
Crankshaft pulley
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09953–05020)
Center Bolt 150
Crankshaft pulley
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09954–05010)
Claw No.1
Crankshaft timing pulley
(09954–05020)
Claw No.2
Crankshaft pulley
09950–70010
Handle Set
(09951–07100)
Handle 100
Valve guide bushing
Crankshaft rear oil seal
Author:
Date:
61
PP–10
PREPARATION
09960–10010
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
Variable Pin Wrench Set
(09962–01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
Camshaft timing pulley
Camshaft sub–gear
(09963–01000)
Pin 10
Camshaft timing pulley
(09963–00500)
Pin 5
Camshaft sub–gear
Author:
Date:
62
PP–11
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
PP0BS–03
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040–00010
Hexagon Wrench Set .
09090–04020
Engine Sling Device
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
09258–00030
Hose Plug Set .
09904–00010
Expander Set .
For suspending engine
Plug for the vacuum hose, fuel
hose etc.
Author:
Date:
63
PP–12
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
PP0BT–03
EQUIPMENT
Abrasive compound
Caliper gauge
CO/HC meter
Connecting rod aligner
Cylinder gauge
Dial indicator
Dye penetrant
Engine tune–up tester
Groove cleaning tool
Heater
Magnetic finger
Micrometer
OBDII scan tool
Pin hole grinder
Piston pin hole
Piston ring compressor
Piston ring expander
Plastigage
Precision straight edge
Ridge reamer
Soft brush
Spring tester
Valve spring
Steel square
Valve spring
Thermometer
Torque wrench
Valve seat cutter
Vernier calipers
Wire brush
Valve
Author:
Date:
64
PP–13
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
PP1WT–01
SSM (Special Service Materials)
08826–00080
Seal Packing Black or equivalent
(FIPG)
Camshaft bearing cap
Semi–circular plug
Cylinder head cover
Rear oil seal retainer
08826–00100
Seal Packing 1282B,
THREE BOND 1282B or equivalent
(FIPG)
Engine coolant drain union
Water seal plate
Water inlet housing
08833–00070
Adhesive 1324,
THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Spark plug tube
Drive plate bolt
08833–00080
Adhesive 1344
THREE BOND 1344
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
No.1 idler pulley pivot bolt
Author:
Date:
65
PP–14
PREPARATION
–
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
PP0JU–04
SST (Special Service Tools)
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
Author:
Date:
66
PP–15
PREPARATION
–
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
PP0JV–04
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Hose clipper
Pressure gauge
Vacuum gauge
Author:
Date:
67
PP–16
PREPARATION
–
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
PP0BV–03
EQUIPMENT
Hose clipper
MITYVAC (Hand–held vacuum pump)
Torque wrench
Author:
Date:
68
PP–17
PREPARATION
–
SFI (5S–FE)
SFI (5S–FE)
PP1WB–02
SST (Special Service Tools)
09268–41047
Injection Measuring Tool Set
(09268–41100)
Clamp
(09268–41110)
Adaptor
(90405–09015)
No.1 Union
09268–45014
Except California
EFI Fuel Pressure Gauge
(09268–41190)
Adaptor
(90405–06167)
I Union
09631–22020
Power Steering Hose Nut
14 x 17 mm Wrench Set
Fuel line flare nut
09816–30010
Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Knock sensor 1
09842–30070
Wiring ”F” EFI Inspection
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
Author:
Date:
69
PP–18
PREPARATION
–
SFI (5S–FE)
PP0JX–04
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09258–00030
Hose Plug Set .
Plug for vacuum hose, fuel hose
etc.
Author:
Date:
70
PP–19
PREPARATION
–
SFI (5S–FE)
PP0JY–04
EQUIPMENT
Carburetor cleaner
Throttle body
Graduated cylinder
Injector
OBDII scan tool
Soft brush
Throttle body
Sound scope
Injector
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
Author:
Date:
71
PP–20
PREPARATION
–
SFI (1MZ–FE)
SFI (1MZ–FE)
PP1WW–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09268–41047
Injection Measuring Tool Set
(09268–41100)
Clamp
Except California
(09268–41300)
Clamp
For California
09268–41250
T Joint
09268–45012
EFI Fuel Pressure Gauge
09631–22020
Power Steering Hose Nut
14 x 17 mm Wrench Set
Fuel line flare nut
09817–16011
Back–up Light Switch Tool
Knock sensor
09842–30070
Wiring ”F” EFI Inspection
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
Author:
Date:
72
PP–21
PREPARATION
–
SFI (1MZ–FE)
PP1WX–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09040–00010
Hexagon Wrench Set .
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
09258–00030
Hose Plug Set .
Plug for the vacuum hose, fuel
hose etc.
Author:
Date:
73
PP–22
PREPARATION
–
SFI (1MZ–FE)
PP1WY–01
EQUIPMENT
Carburetor cleaner
Throttle body
Graduated cylinder
Injector
OBD II scan tool
Soft brush
Throttle body
Sound scope
Injector
Torque wrench
Vacuum gauge
Author:
Date:
74
PP–23
PREPARATION
–
SFI (1MZ–FE)
PP1WZ–01
SSM (Special Service Materials)
08826–00080
Seal Packing Black or equivalent
(FIPG)
Author:
Intake air control valve
Date:
75
PP–24
PREPARATION
–
COOLING (5S–FE)
COOLING (5S–FE)
PP0JZ–05
SST (Special Service Tools)
09230–01010
Radiator Service Tool Set
09231–14010
Punch
Author:
Date:
76
PP–25
PREPARATION
–
COOLING (5S–FE)
PP0K0–03
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
Author:
Date:
77
PP–26
PREPARATION
–
COOLING (5S–FE)
PP0K1–03
EQUIPMENT
Heater
ECT switch, Thermostat
Radiator cap tester
Thermometer
ECT switch, Thermostat
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
Author:
Date:
78
PP–27
PREPARATION
–
COOLING (5S–FE)
PP0K2–03
COOLANT
Item
Engine coolant
Capacity
w/ Oil cooler
w/o Oil cooler
Classification
6.9 liters (7.3 US qts, 6.1 lmp. qts)
6.2 liters (6.5 US qts, 5.4 lmp. qts)
Author:
”Toyota Long Life Coolant” or equivalent
Date:
79
PP–28
PREPARATION
–
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
PP1WU–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09230–01010
Radiator Service Tool Set
09231–14010
Punch
Author:
Date:
80
PP–29
PREPARATION
–
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
PP0C1–03
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
Author:
Date:
81
PP–30
PREPARATION
–
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
PP0C2–02
EQUIPMENT
Heater
ECT switch
Radiator cap tester
Thermometer
ECT switch
Torque wrench
Author:
Date:
82
PP–31
PREPARATION
–
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
PP0C3–04
COOLANT
Item
Engine coolant
Capacity
Classification
9.2 liters (9.7 US qts, 8.1 lmp. qts)
Author:
”Toyota Long Life Coolant” or equivalent
Date:
83
PP–32
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
PP0K3–04
SST (Special Service Tools)
09032–00100
Oil Pan Seal Cutter
09228–06501
Oil Filter Wrench
09950–60010
Replacer Set
(09951–00350)
Replacer 35
09950–70010
Handle Set
(09951–07100)
Handle 100
Oil pump oil seal
Oil pump oil seal
Author:
Date:
84
PP–33
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
PP0K4–04
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
09905–00013
Snap Ring Pliers .
Author:
Date:
85
PP–34
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
PP0K5–04
EQUIPMENT
Oil pressure gauge
Torque wrench
Author:
Date:
86
PP–35
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
PP0K6–04
LUBRICANT
Item
Engine oil
Dry fill
Capacity
Classification
w/ Oil cooler
w/o Oil cooler
4.3 liters (4.5 US qts, 3.8 lmp.qts)
4.2 liters (4.4 US qts, 3.7 lmp.qts)
API grade SJ, Energy–Conserving or ILSAC multigrade engine oil. SAE 5W–30 is the best choice
for your vehicle, for good fuel economy, and good
starting in cold weather
w/ Oil filter change
w/o Oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 lmp.qts)
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 lmp.qts)
Drain and refill
Author:
Date:
87
PP–36
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
PP1WC–01
SSM (Special Service Materials)
08826–00080
Seal Packing Black or equivalent
(FIPG)
Oil pan
08833–00080
Adhesive 1344
THREE BOND 1344
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Oil pressure switch
Author:
Date:
88
PP–37
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
PP0C4–03
SST (Special Service Tools)
09032–00100
Oil Pan Seal Cutter
No.2 oil pan
09223–00010
Cover & Seal Replacer
Crankshaft front oil seal
09228–07501
Oil Filter Wrench
09816–30010
Oil Pressure Switch Socket
Author:
Date:
89
PP–38
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
PP0C5–03
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
Author:
Date:
90
PP–39
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
PP0C6–02
EQUIPMENT
Oil pressure gauge
Precision straight edge
Oil pump
Torque wrench
Author:
Date:
91
PP–40
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
PP0C7–04
LUBRICANT
Item
Engine oil
Dry fill
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change
w/o Oil filter change
Capacity
Classification
5.2 liters (5.5 US qts, 4.6 lmp. qts)
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 lmp. qts)
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 lmp. qts)
Author:
API grade SJ, Energy–Conserving or ILSAC
multigrade engine oil.
SAE 5W–30 is the best choice for your vehicle,
for good fuel economy and good starting in cold
weather.
Date:
92
PP–41
PREPARATION
–
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
PP1WV–01
SSM (Special Service Materials)
08826–00080
Seal Packing Black or equivalent
(FIPG)
Oil pump
No.1 oil pan
No.2 oil pan
08833–00080
Adhesive 1344
THREE BOND 1344
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Oil pressure switch
Author:
Date:
93
PP–42
PREPARATION
–
IGNITION (5S–FE)
IGNITION (5S–FE)
PP0K8–04
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
Author:
Date:
94
PP–43
PREPARATION
–
IGNITION (5S–FE)
PP0K9–04
EQUIPMENT
Megger insulation resistance meter
Spark plug
Spark plug cleaner
Author:
Date:
95
PP–44
PREPARATION
–
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
PP0CF–03
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
Author:
Date:
96
PP–45
PREPARATION
–
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
PP0CG–02
EQUIPMENT
Megger insulation resistance meter
Spark plug
Spark plug cleaner
Author:
Date:
97
PP–46
PREPARATION
–
STARTING (5S–FE)
STARTING(5S–FE)
PP0KA–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09286–46011
Injection Pump Spline Shaft
Puller
Armature bearing
09810–38140
Starter Magnet Switch Nut Wrench
14
Terminal nut
09820–00030
Alternator Rear Bearing Replacer
Armature front bearing
Author:
Date:
98
PP–47
PREPARATION
–
STARTING (5S–FE)
PP0KB–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
Author:
Date:
99
PP–48
PREPARATION
–
STARTING (5S–FE)
PP0KC–01
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Commutator
Magnetic finger
Steel ball
Press
Magnetic switch terminal kit part
Pull scale
Brush spring
Sandpaper
Commutator
Torque wrench
V–block
Commutator
Vernier calipers
Commutator, Brush
Author:
Date:
100
PP–49
PREPARATION
–
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
PP0C9–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09286–46011
Injection Pump Spline Shaft
Puller
Armature bearing
09810–38140
Starter Magnet Switch Nut Wrench
14
Terminal nut
09820–00030
Alternator Rear Bearing Replacer
Armature front bearing
Author:
Date:
101
PP–50
PREPARATION
–
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
PP0CA–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
Author:
Date:
102
PP–51
PREPARATION
–
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
PP0CB–02
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Commutator
Magnetic finger
Steel ball
Press
Magnetic switch terminal kit
Pull scale
Brush spring
Sandpaper
Commutator
Torque wrench
V–block
Commutator
Vernier calipers
Commutator, Brush
Author:
Date:
103
PP–52
PREPARATION
–
CHARGING (5S–FE)
CHARGING(5S–FE)
PP0KD–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09285–76010
Injection Pump Camshaft Bearing
Cone Replacer
Rotor rear bearing cover
09286–46011
Injection Pump Spline Shaft
Puller
Rectifier end frame
09820–00021
Alternator Rear Bearing Puller
09820–00030
Alternator Rear Bearing Replacer
09820–63010
Alternator Pulley Set Nut Wrench
Set
09950–60010
Replacer Set
(09951–00500)
Replacer 50
Rotor rear bearing
Rotor front bearing
Author:
Date:
104
PP–53
PREPARATION
–
CHARGING (5S–FE)
PP0KE–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
Author:
Date:
105
PP–54
PREPARATION
–
CHARGING (5S–FE)
PP0KF–01
EQUIPMENT
Battery specific gravity gauge
Except maintenance free battery
Belt tension gauge
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
Rotor (Slip ring), Brush
Author:
Date:
106
PP–55
PREPARATION
–
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
PP0CC–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09285–76010
Injection Pump Camshaft Bearing
Cone Replacer
Rotor rear bearing cover
09286–46011
Injection Pump Spline Shaft
Puller
Rectifier end frame
09820–00021
Alternator Rear Bearing Puller
09820–00030
Alternator Rear Bearing Replacer
09820–63010
Alternator Pulley Set Nut Wrench
Set
09950–60010
Replacer Set
(09951–00500)
Replacer 50
Rotor rear bearing
Rotor front bearing
Author:
Date:
107
PP–56
PREPARATION
–
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
PP0CD–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
Author:
Date:
108
PP–57
PREPARATION
–
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
PP0CE–02
EQUIPMENT
Ammeter(A)
Battery specific gravity gauge
Except maintenance free battery
Belt tension gauge
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
Rotor (Slip ring), Brush
Author:
Date:
109
PP–58
PREPARATION
–
CLUTCH
CLUTCH
PP0HC–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09023–00100
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
Clutch line
09301–00210
Clutch Guide Tool
5S–FE Engine
09301–00220
Clutch Guide Tool
1MZ–FE Engine
09333–00013
Clutch Diaphragm Spring Aligner
Author:
Date:
110
PP–59
PREPARATION
–
CLUTCH
PP0HD–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09905–00013
Snap Ring Pliers .
Author:
Date:
111
PP–60
PREPARATION
–
CLUTCH
PP0HE–01
EQUIPMENT
Calipers
Dial indicator
Torque wrench
Author:
Date:
112
PP–61
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
PP0H7–03
SST (Special Service Tools)
09223–15020
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
Differential case oil seal
09308–00010
Oil Seal Puller
Output shaft front bearing outer
race
09316–20011
Transfer Bearing Replacer
Differential case tapered roller
bearing
09316–60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316–00011)
Replacer Pipe
(09316–00021)
Replacer ”A”
(09316–00041)
Replacer ”C”
1st gear
No.1 hub sleeve
Differential case tapered roller
bearing outer race
Replacer ”F”
Output shaft front bearing
09506–30012
Differential Drive Pinion Rear
Bearing Cone Replacer
Output shaft rear bearing
09506–35010
Differential Drive Pinion Rear
Bearing Replacer
No.2 hub sleeve
3rd gear
Input shaft rear bearing
09608–00081
Differential Side Bearing Cone
Replacer
Input shaft oil seal
09612–65014
Steering Worm Bearing Puller
Input shaft bearing
Differential case tapered roller
bearing outer race
(09316–00071)
Author:
Date:
113
PP–62
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
09950–00020
Bearing Remover
09950–00030
Bearing Remover Attachment
Output shaft front bearing
09950–30010
Puller A Set
5th driven gear
No.3 clutch hub
09950–40011
Puller B Set
Differential case tapered roller bearing
09950–60010
Replacer Set
(09951–00310)
Replacer 31
Control shaft cover oil seal
Installation
(09951–00580)
Replacer 58
Input shaft bearing
09950–70010
Handle Set
(09951–07150)
Handle 150
Author:
Date:
114
PP–63
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
PP0H8–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf–cm)
09031–00030
Pin Punch .
09040–00010
Hexagon Wrench Set .
09042–00040
Torx Socket T50 .
09042–00050
Torx Socket T45 .
09090–04010
Engine Sling Device .
09905–00012
Snap Ring No.1 Expander .
Author:
Differential preload
Date:
115
PP–64
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
PP0H9–01
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Feeler gauge
Micrometer
Torque wrench
Precision straight edge
Magnetic finger
Author:
Date:
116
PP–65
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
PP0HA–01
LUBRICANT
Item
Manual transaxle oil
(w/ Differential oil)
Capacity
Classification
4.2 liters (4.4 US qts, 3.7 Imp. qts)
Author:
API GL–4 or GL–5
SAE 75W–90
Date:
117
PP–66
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
PP0H2–04
SST (Special Service Tools)
09308–00010
Oil Seal Puller
Input shaft front bearing
Output shaft front bearing
09309–12020
5th Driven Gear Replacer
5th driven gear
09310–35010
Countershaft Bearing Replacer
Input shaft front bearing
Output shaft front bearing
09316–60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
(09316–00011)
Replacer Pipe
3rd driven gear
Differential side bearing
(09316–00041)
Replacer ”C”
Output shaft thrust washer
09350–32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09351–32120)
Overdrive Bearing Replacer
Differential side bearing
(09351–32130)
Handle
Differential side bearing
retainer oil seal
Differential case oil seal
(Transaxle case side)
(09351–32150)
Oil Seal Replacer
Differential side bearing
retainer oil seal
Differential case oil seal
(Transaxle case side)
09564–32011
Differential Preload Adaptor
09608–00071
Drive Pinion Rear Bearing Cone
Replacer
Author:
Input shaft rear bearing
Date:
118
PP–67
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
09608–00081
Differential Side Bearing Cone
Replacer
Input shaft front oil seal
09612–22011
Tilt Handle Bearing Replacer
Output shaft rear bearing
No.3 clutch hub
09950–00020
Bearing Remover
09950–00030
Bearing Remover Attachment
09950–30010
Puller A Set
No.3 clutch hub
09950–40011
Puller B Set
5th driven gear
09950–60020
Replacer Set No.2
Differential side bearing
retainer oil seal
Differential side bearing
outer race
(09951–00680)
Replacer 68
09950–70010
Handle Set
(09951–07150)
Handle 150
Author:
Date:
119
PP–68
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
PP0H3–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf–cm)
09031–00030
Pin Punch .
09040–00010
Hexagon Wrench Set .
09090–04010
Engine Sling Device .
09905–00012
Snap Ring No.1 Expander .
Author:
Differential preload
Date:
120
PP–69
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
PP0H4–01
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Torque wrench
Feeler gauge
Magnetic finger
Micrometer
Author:
Date:
121
PP–70
PREPARATION
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
PP0H5–01
LUBRICANT
Item
Manual transaxle oil
(w/ Differential oil)
Capacity
Classification
2.6 liters (2.7 US qts, 2.3 lmp. qts)
Author:
API GL–4 or GL–5
SAE 75W–90
Date:
122
PP–71
PREPARATION
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
PP0KG–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09308–00010
Oil Seal Puller
09350–32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09351–32010)
One–way Clutch Test Tool
(09351–32020)
Stator Stopper
(09351–32130)
Handle
(09351–32150)
Oil Seal Replacer
09992–00095
Automatic Transmission Oil
Pressure Gauge Set
(09992–00231)
Adaptor C
(09992–00271)
Gauge Assy
Author:
Date:
123
PP–72
PREPARATION
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
PP0KH–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09090–04010
Engine Sling Device .
Author:
Date:
124
PP–73
PREPARATION
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
PP0KI–01
EQUIPMENT
OBD II scan tool
Torque wrench
Hexagon wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Drive plate
Vernier calipers
Torque converter clutch
Straight edge
Torque converter clutch
Author:
Date:
125
PP–74
PREPARATION
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
PP0KJ–01
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Classification
Automatic transaxle
Dry fill
Drain and refill
5.6 liters (5.9 US qts, 4.9 Imp.qts)
2.5 liters (2.6 US qts, 2.2 Imp.qts)
ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
Differential oil
1.6 liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp.qts)
ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
Author:
Date:
126
PP–75
PREPARATION
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
PP0M1–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09223–15020
Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer
09308–00010
Oil Seal Puller
Side gear shaft oil seal
09316–60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
RH side bearing
Replacer Pipe
RH side gear shaft oil seal
(09316–00011)
09350–32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
(09351–32010)
One–way Clutch Test Tool
(09351–32020)
Stator Stopper
(09351–32130)
Handle
09992–00095
Automatic Transmission Oil
Pressure Gauge Set
(09992–00231)
Adaptor C
(09992–00271)
Gauge Assy
Author:
Line pressure
Date:
127
PP–76
PREPARATION
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
PP0M2–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09090–04010
Engine Sling Device .
Author:
Date:
128
PP–77
PREPARATION
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
PP0M3–01
EQUIPMENT
Straight edge
Torque converter clutch
Vernier calipers
Torque converter clutch
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
Drive plate
Hexagon Wrench (10 mm)
Torque wrench
OBD II scan tool
Author:
Date:
129
PP–78
PREPARATION
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
PP0M4–01
LUBRICANT
Item
Automatic transaxle fluid
(w/o Differential oil)
Dry fill
Drain and refill
Capacity
Classification
8.0 liters (8.5 US qts, 7.0 Imp. qts)
3.9 liters (4.1 US qts, 3.4 Imp. qts)
Author:
ATF D–II or DEXRON®III (DEXRON®II)
Date:
130
PP–79
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
PP1WM–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09223–56010
Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal
Replacer
Front drive shaft
09240–00020
Wire Gauge Set
Front drive shaft
09309–36010
Transmission Rear Bearing
Replacer
Front drive shaft
09310–35010
Countershaft Bearing Replacer
Front axle hub
09316–20011
Transfer Bearing Replacer
Front drive shaft
09316–60011
Transmission & Transfer Bearing
Replacer
Front axle hub
Front suspension
(09316–00011)
Replacer Pipe
(09316–00041)
Replacer ”C”
09506–35010
Differential Drive Pinion Rear
Bearing Replacer
Front drive shaft
09520–00031
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
Front axle hub
09521–24010
Drive Shaft Boot Clamping Tool
Front drive shaft
09527–17011
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
Front axle hub
Author:
Date:
131
PP–80
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
09555–55010
Differential Drive Pinion
Bearing Replacer
Front drive shaft
09608–16042
Front Hub Bearing Adjusting Tool
Front drive shaft
(09608–02021)
Bolt & Nut
(09608–02041)
Retainer
09608–32010
Steering Knuckle Oil Seal
Replacer
Front axle hub
Front suspension
09610–20012
Pitman Arm Puller
Front axle hub
09628–10011
Ball Joint Puller
Front axle hub
Rear axle hub
09628–62011
Ball Joint Puller
Front axle hub
Front suspension
09727–30021
Coil Spring Compressor
Front suspension
Rear suspension
09729–22031
Front Spring Upper Seat Holder
Front suspension
09950–00020
Bearing Remover
Front axle hub
Front drive shaft
09950–60010
Replacer Set
Front axle hub
(09951–00400)
Replacer 40
Author:
Date:
132
PP–81
PREPARATION
–
09950–70010
Handle Set
(09951–07100)
Handle 100
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
Front axle hub
Author:
Date:
133
PP–82
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
PP08W–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf–cm)
09042–00010
Torx Socket T30 .
09905–00012
Snap Ring No.1 Expander .
09905–00013
Snap Ring Pliers .
Author:
Date:
134
PP–83
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
PP08X–03
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator
Drill
Torque wrench
Author:
Date:
135
PP–84
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
PP08Y–01
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
5S–FE:
Outboard joint grease
Color=Black
Inboard joint grease Color=Yellow ocher
140 – 160 g (5.5 – 6.3 oz.)
185 – 215 g (7.3 – 8.5 oz.)
1MZ–FE:
Outboard joint grease
Inboard joint grease
Color=Black
Color=Gray
Joint side
Boot side
Application
105 – 125 g (3.7 – 4.4 oz.)
142.5 – 157.5 g (5.0 – 5.6 oz.)
52.5 – 57.5 g (2.1 – 2.3 oz.)
Author:
Date:
136
PP–85
PREPARATION
–
BRAKE
BRAKE
PP0I7–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09023–00100
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
09703–30010
Brake Shoe Return Spring Tool
09709–29018
LSPV Gauge Set
09718–00010
Shoe Hold Down Spring Driver
09737–00010
Brake Booster Push Rod Gauge
09751–36011
Brake Line Union Nut 10 x 12 mm
Wrench
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
09990–00150
ABS Actuator Checker and
Sub–harness
DENSO type ABS,
ABS & TRAC type
09990–00163
ABS Actuator Checker Sheet ”A”
ABS & TRAC type
09990–00250
ABS Actuator Checker Sub–harness
”G”
DENSO type ABS,
ABS & TRAC type
09990–00300
ABS Actuator Checker Sub–harness
”I”
DENSO type ABS
09990–00360
ABS Actuator Checker Sub–harness
”L”
DENSO type ABS,
ABS & TRAC type
Author:
Date:
137
PP–86
PREPARATION
–
BRAKE
09990–00430
ABS Actuator Checker Sheet ”P”
DENSO type ABS
09990–00450
ABS Actuator Checker Sub–harness
”P”
ABS & TRAC type
Author:
Date:
138
PP–87
PREPARATION
–
BRAKE
PP0I8–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042–00030
Torx Socket T20 .
BOSCH type ABS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09905–00013
Snap Ring Pliers .
Author:
Date:
139
PP–88
PREPARATION
–
BRAKE
PP0I9–03
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Micrometer
Brake disc
Dial indicator
Brake disc
Brake drum gauge
Brake drum and disc
Vernier calipers
Brake drum
Author:
Date:
140
PP–89
PREPARATION
–
BRAKE
PP0IA–01
LUBRICANT
Item
Brake fluid
Capacity
Classification
–
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT3
Author:
Date:
141
PP–90
PREPARATION
–
STEERING
STEERING
PP0DB–03
SST (Special Service Tools)
09249–63010
Torque Wrench Adaptor
PS vane pump
09521–24010
Drive Shaft Boot Clamping Tool
PS gear
09527–20011
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
PS gear
09612–00012
Rack & Pinion Steering Rack
Housing Stand
PS gear
09612–22011
Tilt Handle Bearing Replacer
PS gear
09612–24014
Steering Gear Housing Overhaul
Tool Set
Steering Rack Shaft Bushing
Puller
PS gear
09616–00010
Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Socket
PS gear
09631–10021
Rack Stopper Wrench
PS gear
09631–12071
Steering Rack Oil Seal Test Tool
PS gear
09631–20081
Seal Ring Tool
PS gear
09631–22020
Power Steering Hose Nut
14 x 17 mm Wrench Set
PS vane pump
PS gear
(09613–22011)
Author:
Date:
142
PP–91
PREPARATION
–
STEERING
09631–33010
Steering Rack Cover ”I”
PS gear
09633–00020
Power Steering Hose Nut Wrench
PS gear
09640–10010
Power Steering Pressure Gauge
Set
(09641–01010)
Gauge Assy
Power steering fluid
(09641–01030)
Attachment B
Power steering fluid
(09641–01060)
Attachment E
Power steering fluid
09922–10010
Variable Open Wrench
PS gear
09950–50012
Puller C Set
(09951–05010)
Hanger 150
Tilt steering column
(09952–05010)
Slide Arm
Tilt steering column
(09953–05020)
Center Bolt 150
Tilt steering column
(09954–05020)
Claw No.2
Tilt steering column
09950–60010
Replacer Set
Author:
Date:
143
PP–92
PREPARATION
–
STEERING
(09951–00180)
Replacer 18
PS gear
(09951–00240)
Replacer 24
PS gear
(09951–00250)
Replacer 25
PS gear
(09951–00260)
Replacer 26
PS gear
(09951–00290)
Replacer 29
PS gear
(09951–00310)
Replacer 31
PS gear
(09951–00320)
Replacer 32
PS gear
(09951–00330)
Replacer 33
PS vane pump
(09951–00340)
Replacer 34
PS gear
(09951–00400)
Replacer 40
PS gear
(09951–00430)
Replacer 43
PS gear
(09952–06010)
Adapter
PS gear
09950–70010
Handle Set
Author:
Date:
144
PP–93
PREPARATION
–
STEERING
(09951–07100)
Handle 100
PS vane pump
(09951–07200)
Handle 200
PS gear
(09951–07360)
Handle 360
PS gear
09960–10010
Variable Pin Wrench Set
(09962–01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assy
PS vane pump
(09963–01000)
Pin 10
PS vane pump
Author:
Date:
145
PP–94
PREPARATION
–
STEERING
PP0DC–03
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010
Torque Wrench (30 ) .
PS vane pump
PS gear
09042–00010
Torx Socket T30 .
Tilt steering column
09904–00010
Expander Set .
09905–00012
Snap Ring No.1 Expander .
09905–00013
Snap Ring Pliers .
Author:
Date:
146
PP–95
PREPARATION
–
STEERING
PP0DD–05
EQUIPMENT
Belt tension gauge
On–vehicle inspection
Caliper gauge
PS vane pump
Calipers
PS vane pump
Dial indicator
PS gear
Feeler gauge
PS vane pump
Micrometer
PS vane pump
Torque wrench
Author:
Date:
147
PP–96
PREPARATION
–
STEERING
PP0DE–05
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Classification
Power steering fluid
Total
0.8 liters (0.8 US qts, 0.7 lmp.qts)
ATF DEXRON® II or III
Author:
Date:
148
PP–97
PREPARATION
–
STEERING
PP1XK–01
SSM (Special Service Materials)
08833–00080
Adhesive 1344
THREE BOND 1344
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Author:
PS gear
Date:
149
PP–98
PREPARATION
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PP0MQ–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09082–00700
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
09082–00750
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub–harness No.3
09082–00760
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub–harness No.4
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
Author:
Date:
150
PP–99
PREPARATION
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PP1XL–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042–00020
Torx Socket T40 .
09082–00050
TOYOTA Electrical Tester Set.
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
(09083–00150)
Airbag sensor assembly
Test Lead Set
Seat belt pretensioner connector
Author:
Date:
151
PP–100
PREPARATION
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PP0MS–01
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Bolt: Length: 35 mm (1.38 in.) Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Diam.: 6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire
Airbag disposal
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.) Inner diam.: 360mm (14.17 in.)
Tire with disc wheel
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diam.: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Vinyl bag
Airbag disposal
Author:
Date:
152
PP–101
PREPARATION
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
BODY ELECTRICAL
PP0KY–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
Author:
Date:
153
PP–102
PREPARATION
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
PP0KZ–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09041–00030
Torx Driver T30 .
For removing and installing
steering wheel pad
09042–00010
Torx Socket T30 .
For removing and installing
steering wheel pad
Author:
Date:
154
PP–103
PREPARATION
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
PP0L0–01
EQUIPMENT
Voltmeter
Ammeter
Ohmmeter
Test lead
Syphon
Brake fluid level warning switch
Bulb (3.4 W)
Fuel sender gauge, Seat belt warning relay
Bulb (21 W)
Turn signal flasher relay
Dry cell battery
Fuel sender gauge
Torque wrench
Masking tape
Rear window defogger wire
Tin foil
Rear window defogger wire
Author:
Date:
155
PP–104
PREPARATION
–
BODY
BODY
PP0MU–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09804–24010
Luggage Compartment Door Torsion
Bar Tool
09812–00020
Door Hinge Set Bolt Wrench
Author:
Date:
156
PP–105
PREPARATION
–
BODY
PP0MV–01
EQUIPMENT
Clip remover
Torque wrench
Drill
Drill bit, diam 3.2 mm (0.126 in.)
Hand riveter
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Adhesive tape
To avoid surface damage
Adhesive
Cleaner
Shop rag
Regulator handle
Water pump pliers
Window regulator
Knife
Moulding
Heat light
Moulding
Piano wire
Windshield
Rope (no projections, difficult to break)
Seat belt pretensioner disposal
Tire Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diam: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Seatbelt pretensioner disposal
Tire with disc wheel Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diam 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Seat belt pretinsioner disposal
Vinyl bag
Seat belt pretensioner disposal
Author:
Date:
157
PP–106
PREPARATION
–
BODY
PP0MW–01
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Classification
MP grease
–
–
Author:
Date:
158
PP–107
PREPARATION
–
AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
PP1XJ–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
07110–58060
Air Conditioner Service Tool Set
(07117–58060)
Refrigerant Drain Service Valve
(07117–58070)
T–Joint
(07117–58080)
Quick Disconnect Adapter
Discharge (diam. 16 mm)
(07117–58090)
Quick Disconnect Adapter
Suction (diam. 13 mm)
(07117–78050)
Refrigerant Charging Gauge
(07117–88060)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
Discharge (Red)
(07117–88070)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
Suction (Blue)
(07117–88080)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
Utility (Green)
07112–66040
Magnetic Clutch Remover
07112–76060
Magnetic Clutch Stopper
07114–84010
Snap Ring Pliers
Author:
Date:
159
PP–108
PREPARATION
–
AIR CONDITIONING
07114–84020
Snap Ring Pliers
07116–38360
Gas Leak Detector Assembly
09870–00015
A/C Quick Joint Puller No.1
Suction tube
09870–00025
A/C Quick Joint Puller No.2
Liquid tube
Author:
Date:
160
PP–109
PREPARATION
–
AIR CONDITIONING
PP0B7–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
09216–00021
Belt Tension Gauge .
Author:
Date:
161
PP–110
PREPARATION
–
AIR CONDITIONING
PP0B8–02
EQUIPMENT
Voltmeter
Ammeter
Ohmmeter
Test lead
Thermometer
Thermistor, ECT switch
Torque wrench
Dial indicator
Magnetic clutch
Plastic hammer
Magnetic clutch
Author:
Date:
162
PP–111
PREPARATION
–
AIR CONDITIONING
PP0B9–02
LUBRICANT
Item
Compressor oil
When replacing receiver
Capacity
Classification
–
ND–OIL 8 or equivalent
20 cc (0.71 fl.oz.)
When replacing condenser
40 – 50 cc (1.4 – 1.7 fl.oz.)
When replacing evaporator
40 – 50 cc (1.4 – 1.7 fl.oz.)
When replacing compressor
120 cc (4.1 fl.oz.)
Author:
Date:
163
PP–1
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PP24T–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
Author:
Date:
43
PP–2
PREPARATION
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
PP0JS–05
EQUIPMENT
CO/HC meter
Compression gauge
Micrometer
OBDII scan tool
Torque wrench
Vernier calipers
PP–3
PREPARATION
–
SFI
SFI
PP24U–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
Author:
Date:
45
PP–4
PREPARATION
–
SFI
PP0JY–05
EQUIPMENT
Sound scope
Torque wrench
Injector
PP–5
PREPARATION
–
IGNITION
IGNITION
PP24V–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09200–00010
Engine Adjust Kit .
Author:
Date:
47
PP–6
PREPARATION
–
IGNITION
PP0K9–04
EQUIPMENT
Megger insulation resistance meter
Spark plug cleaner
Spark plug
PP–7
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
PP24O–01
SST (Special Service Tools)
09608–16042
Front Hub Bearing Adjusting Tool
(09608–02021)
Bolt & Nut
(09608–02041)
Retainer
Front drive shaft
09610–20012
Pitman Arm Puller
Front drive shaft
09950–00020
Bearing Remover
Front drive shaft
09309–36010
Transmission Rear Bearing
Replacer
09316–20011
Transfer Bearing Replacer
09506–35010
Differential Drive Pinion Rear
Bearing Replacer
09521–24010
Drive Shaft Boot Clamping Tool
Author:
Date:
49
PP–8
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
PP24P–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025–00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf–cm)
PP–9
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
PP24Q–01
EQUIPMENT
Digital indicator with magnetic base
Torque wrench
PP–10
PREPARATION
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
PP24R–01
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Outboard joint grease
Color=Black
Inboard joint grease Color=Yellow ocher
100 – 120 g (3.5 – 4.2 oz.)
125 – 155 g (4.4 – 5.5 oz.)
Application
PP–11
PREPARATION
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
BODY ELECTRICAL
PP0KY–02
SST (Special Service Tools)
09843–18020
Diagnosis Check Wire
Author:
Date:
53
PP–12
PREPARATION
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
PP24S–01
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082–00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester.
PP–13
PREPARATION
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
PP0L0–02
EQUIPMENT
Voltmeter
Ammeter
Ohmmeter
Test lead
Bulb (3.4 W)
Torque wrench
Fuel sender gauge, Engine coolant temperature sender gauge
PP–14
PREPARATION
–
BODY
BODY
PP24Z–01
EQUIPMENT
Clip remover
Torque wrench
Hog ring pliers
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Adhesive tape
To avoid surface damage
Adhesive
Cleaner
Shop rag
Regulator handle
Knife
Moulding
Piano wire
Back window glass
Sealer gun
Brush
Putty spatula
Wooden block or similar object
For tying both piano wire ends
Author:
Date:
56
PP–15
PREPARATION
–
BODY
PP250–01
LUBRICANT
Item
MP grease
Capacity
Classification
–
–
PP–16
PREPARATION
–
BODY
PP251–01
SSM (Special Service Materials)
08833–00030
Three cement black or equivalent
08850–00801
Windshield Glass Adhesive Set
or equivalent
MX–1
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
MANUAL TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
MX04X–01
PRECAUTION
When working with FIPG material, you must observe the following items.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all the old FIPG material from the gasket surfaces.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
Clean both sealing surfaces with a non–residue solvent.
Apply FIPG in an approx. 1 mm (0.04 in.) wide bead along the sealing surface.
Parts must be assembled within 10 minutes of application. Otherwise, the FIPG material must
be removed and reapplied.
Author:
Date:
1802
MX–2
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
MX04Y–01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
N i
Noise
1. Oil (Level low)
2. Oil (Wrong)
3. Gear (Worn or damaged)
4. Bearing (Worn or damaged)
MX–4
MX–4
MX–10
MX
10
MX–10
Oil leakage
l k
1. Oil (Level too high)
2. Gasket (Damaged)
3. Oil seal (Worn or damaged)
4. O–Ring (Worn or damaged)
MX–4
MX–10
MX–10
MX
10
MX–10
1. Control cable (Faulty)
2. Synchronizer
y
ring
g (Worn
(
or damaged)
g )
MX–49
MX–10
MX–24
MX–31
MX–10
MX–24
MX–31
Hard to shift or will not shift
3.
3 Shift key spring (Damaged)
J
Jumps
outt off gear
1. Locking ball spring (Damaged)
2. Shift fork (Worn)
3. Gear (Worn or damaged)
4. Bearing (Worn or damaged)
Author:
MX–10
MX–10
MX–10
MX
10
MX–10
Date:
1803
MX–3
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
MX04Z–01
COMPONENTS
w/ Cruise Control :
Cruise Control Actuator
Hood
14 (150, 10)
13 (130, 9)
Control
Cable
Clip
12 (120, 9)
Clutch Line Bracket
21 (210, 15)
Clip
Washer
Starter
12 (120, 9)
Clutch Release Cylinder
21 (210, 15)
26 (270, 20)
RH Fender
Apron Seal
RH Drive Shaft
32 (330, 24)
Air Cleaner
Case Assembly
with Air Hose
Clutch Accumulator
Vehicle Speed Sensor
39 (400, 29)
Connector
64 (650, 47)
Ground Cable
Transaxle
Back–Up Light Switch Connector
x5
Snap Ring
Engine Wire
20 (200, 14)
7.8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
RH Exhaust Manifold Stay
Flywheel Housing Under Cover
46 (470, 34)
37 (380, 27)
Snap
Ring
LH Fender Apron Seal
64 (650, 47)
19 (195, 14)
36 (370, 27)
10 (100, 7)
PS Gear Assembly
181 (1,850, 134)
No.1 Fuel Tube Protector
Steering Return Pipe
32 (330, 24)
49 (500, 36)
66 (670, 48)
181 (1,850, 134)
294 (3,000, 217)
Lock Cap
Silver Bolt : 44 (450, 33)
Green Bolt : 66 (670, 48)
Cotter
Pin
Pin
Rear LH Suspension Member Brace
Stabilizer Bar Link
Suspension Member with
Lower Suspension Arm
Silver Bolt : 44 (450, 33)
Green Bolt : 66 (670, 48)
Cotter
36 (370, 27)
181 (1,850, 134)
Hole
Plug
127 (1,300, 94)
Gasket
39 (400, 29)
48 (490, 35)
Front LH Suspension
Member Brace
Gasket
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
80 (820, 59)
RH Fender
Liner
Battery
LH Drive Shaft
Engine LH Mounting
64 (650, 47)
Insulator with Bracket
Rear RH Suspension Member Brace
Front RH Suspension
Member Brace
Hold–Down
Clamp
62 (630, 46)
Front Exhaust Pipe
No.1 Exhaust Pipe
Support Bracket
62 (630, 46)
33 (330, 24)
Exhaust Pipe Support Stay
Engine Rear Side
Shutter Plate
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
LH Fender
Liner
33 (330, 24)
Q09981
Author:
Date:
1804
MX–4
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
MX050–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE HOOD
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Adjust the hood.
(See page BO–10)
2.
REMOVE BATTERY AND AIR CLEANER CASE ASSEMBLY WITH AIR HOSE
3.
(a)
(b)
Q09982
4.
(a)
(b)
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Q09983
w/ Cruise Control:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Disconnect the cruise control actuator connector.
Remove the 3 bolts and cruise control actuator with the
bracket.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
REMOVE STARTER
Disconnect the connector and wire from the starter.
Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
DISCONNECT CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the release cylinder.
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 set bolts and nut of the clutch accumulator.
Torque:
Bolt: 21 N·m (210 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
Nut: 26 N·m (270 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
Remove the set bolt of the clutch line bracket.
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
6.
DISCONNECT GROUND CABLE
Remove the set bolt of the ground cable from the transaxle.
Q09984
7.
8.
9.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM CLAMP
DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR AND
BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH CONNECTORS
DISCONNECT CONTROL CABLE
Remove the 2 clips and washers.
Remove the 2 clips from the cables.
Q09985
Author:
Date:
1805
MX–5
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
10.
Q09986
REMOVE 5 TRANSAXLE UPPER SIDE MOUNTING
BOLTS
Torque:
17 mm head: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
11. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
12. RAISE VEHICLE
NOTICE:
Make sure that the vehicle is securely supported.
13. REMOVE ENGINE REAR SIDE SHUTTER PLATE AND
LH AND RH FENDER APRON SEALS
14.
Filler Plug
Oil Level
0 – 5 mm
15.
DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
Oil grade: API GL–4 or GL–5
Viscosity: SAE 75W–90
Capacity: 4.2 liters (4.4 US qts, 3.7 Imp. qts)
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
REMOVE LH AND RH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–25)
Drain Plug
Q09987
16.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Q09988
(d)
(e)
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust pipe support stay.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Remove the 4 nuts and 2 gaskets from the exhaust manifold.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 bolts, nuts and gasket.
Torque: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 set bolts of the No.1 exhaust pipe support
bracket.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Remove the front exhaust pipe.
Author:
Date:
1806
MX–6
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
17.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
DISCONNECT PS GEAR ASSEMBLY FROM FRONT
SUSPENSION MEMBER
Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the stabilizer bar link
from the stabilizer bar.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Remove the 4 set bolts of the stabilizer bar bracket.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 bolts, nut and No.1 fuel tube protector.
Q09989
(d)
(e)
Tie the PS gear assembly to the proper position with a
code or an equivalent to suspend the assembly securely.
Remove the 2 set bolts and nuts of the PS gear assembly.
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
Q09990
18.
DISCONNECT FRONT ENGINE ABSORBER FROM
TRANSAXLE
Remove the 2 bolts.
Torque: 48 N·m (490 kgf·cm, 35 ft·lbf)
Q09991
19. REMOVE RH EXHAUST MANIFOLD STAY
Remove the bolt, nut and stay.
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Q09992
20.
REMOVE 3 ENGINE FRONT SIDE MOUNTING BOLTS
Torque:
Silver bolt: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 33 ft·lbf)
Green bolt: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
Q09993
Author:
Date:
1807
MX–7
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
21.
(a)
(b)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
REMOVE LH ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR WITH
BRACKET
Remove the 2 hole plugs, nuts and 3 bolts.
Torque:
Bolt: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
Nut: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
Lift up the transaxle and remove the left engine mounting
insulator with the bracket.
Q09994
22.
Q09995
C
A
C
A
C
C
14 mm Head B
A A
B
B
Q09996
REMOVE HOLE PLUG AND 4 ENGINE REAR SIDE
MOUNTING NUTS
Torque: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
23. ATTACH ENGINE SLING DEVICE TO ENGINE HANGER
(See page EM–69)
24. DISCONNECT STEERING RETURN PIPE FROM
FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
Remove the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
25. REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER WITH LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Remove the LH and RH fender liner set screws.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts, 4 nuts, front LH and RH suspension
member braces, rear LH and RH suspension member
braces and front suspension member with the lower suspension arm.
Torque:
Bolt A: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
Bolt B: 32 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Nut C: 36 N·m (370 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
26. JACK UP TRANSAXLE SLIGHTLY
Using a transmission jack, support the transaxle.
27.
14 mm Head B
(a)
(b)
14 mm Head A
REMOVE FLYWHEEL HOUSING UNDER COVER AND
TRANSAXLE LOWER SIDE MOUNTING BOLT
Remove the 2 bolts and cover.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
Remove the 3 bolts of the transaxle lower side.
Torque:
14 mm head A: 46 N·m (470 kgf·cm, 34 ft·lbf)
14 mm head B: 37 N·m (380 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Q09997
Author:
Date:
1808
MX–8
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
28. REMOVE TRANSAXLE
Lower the engine left side and remove the transaxle from the
engine.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Align the input shaft with the clutch disc and install the
transaxle to the engine.
Temporarily tighten the transaxle mounting bolts.
Author:
Date:
1809
MX–9
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
MX051–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page MX–4).
HINT:
After installation, check and inspect items as follows.
Front wheel alignment (See page SA–4).
Do the road test.
Author:
Date:
1810
MX–10
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MX052–02
COMPONENTS
Clutch Release Fork Assembly
with Bearing
Clutch Release Fork Support
17 (175, 13)
Control Level Housing
Support Bracket
47 (480, 35)
O–ring
Boot
17 (175, 13)
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Clutch Release
Line Bracket
Transaxle Case Receiver
Cover
7.4 (75, 65 in.·lbf)
17 (175, 13)
17 (175, 13)
Transaxle Case
Transmission
Oil Cooler
Sub–Assembly
34 (350, 25)
Elbow
Transmission Oil Pipe
O–ring
27 (275, 20)
Output Shaft Cover
Tapered Roller Bearing
Outer Race
Front Oil Seal
Transmission Oil
Pipe
Magnet
17 (175, 13)
17 (175, 13)
Input Shaft Front
Bearing
17 (175, 13)
Transmission Oil Pump
Assembly
Differential Case Assembly
Oil Pump Drive Gear
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z19124
Author:
Date:
1811
MX–11
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Reverse Shift Arm Bracket Assembly
Snap Ring
Reverse Shift Fork
No.1 Shift Fork
24 (240, 17)
Straight Screw Plug
25 (250, 18)
Ball
Seat
Spring
No.1 Shift Fork Shaft
17 (175, 13)
Snap Ring
Interlock Roller
25 (250, 18)
No.2 Shift Fork Shaft
Snap Ring
No.3 Shift Fork Shaft
Snap Ring
25 (250, 18)
Shift Head
No.3 Shift Fork
24 (240, 17)
40 (410, 30)
Gasket
Straight Screw Plug
13 (130, 9)
Slotted Spring
Pin
Reverse Restrict
Gasket
Pin
No.2 Oil Receiver Pipe
No.2 Shift Fork
24 (240, 17)
Back–Up Light Switch
Shift and Select Lever
Shaft Lock Bolt
49 (500, 36)
Gasket
Breather Plug
20 (200, 14)
Gasket
49 (500, 36)
x 17
17 (175, 13)
20 (200, 14)
Shift and Select Lever
Shaft Assembly
No.1 Oil Receiver Pipe
29 (300, 22)
Gasket
No.2 Selecting Bellcrank with
Selecting Bellcrank Support
Gasket
29 (300, 22)
Filler Plug
49 (500, 36)
Drain Plug
49 (500, 36)
x 10
Transmission Case
Transmission Case Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Precoated part
Q10278
Author:
Date:
1812
MX–12
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Input Shaft Assembly
Tapered Roller Bearing
Outer Race
Output Shaft Assembly
Reverse Idler Gear
Reverse Idler Gear Shaft
Shim
Lock Bolt
29 (300, 22)
Thrust Washer
42 (430, 31)
x7
Rear Bearing Retainer
Snap Ring
Spacer
5th Driven Gear
Needle Roller Bearing
Key Spring
5th Gear
Inner Synchronizer Ring
Middle Synchronizer Ring
Outer Synchronizer Ring
Synchronizer Pull Ring
Snap Ring
Output Shaft Lock Nut
123 (1,250, 90)
Key Spring
No.3 Clutch Hub
No.3 Hub Sleeve
Snap Ring
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Precoated part
Z17555
Author:
Date:
1813
MX–13
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MX053–02
DISASSEMBLY
1.
2.
REMOVE RELEASE FORK AND BEARING
REMOVE BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH WITH GASKET
Torque: 40 N·m (410 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
3.
REMOVE BOLT AND VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
Torque: 17 N·m (175 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
4.
REMOVE NO.2 SELECTING BELLCRANK WITH SELECTING BELLCRANK SUPPORT
Remove the 2 bolts and No.2 selecting bellcrank with the selecting bellcrank support.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
5.
REMOVE SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT LOCK
BOLT WITH GASKET
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
6.
REMOVE SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT ASSEMBLY WITH GASKET
Remove the 4 bolts, shift and select lever shaft assembly and
gasket.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
7.
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CASE COVER
Remove the 10 bolts and transmission case cover.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826 – 00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
8.
REMOVE BREATHER PLUG WITH GASKET
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
FIPG
Q05816
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
10.
(a)
Q00449
(b)
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT LOCK NUT
Unstake the lock nut.
Engage the gear double meshing.
Remove the lock nut.
Torque: 123 N·m (1,250 kgf·cm, 90 ft·lbf)
Disengage the gear double meshing.
REMOVE NO.3 HUB SLEEVE AND NO.3 SHIFT FORK
Remove the No.3 shift fork set bolt.
Torque: 24 N·m (240 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
Remove the No.3 hub sleeve and No.3 shift fork.
Author:
Date:
1814
MX–14
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
11. REMOVE 5TH DRIVEN GEAR
Using SST, remove the 5th driven gear.
SST 09950–30010
SST
Q05849
12.
MEASURE 5TH GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE AND
RADIAL CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.10 – 0.57 mm (0.0039 – 0.0224 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.65 mm (0.0256 in.)
(a)
Z01304
(b)
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.009 – 0.050 mm (0.0004 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
REMOVE NO.3 CLUTCH HUB AND 5TH GEAR
Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the snap
ring.
13.
(a)
Z01306
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial play.
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
a
1.75 (0.0689)
f
2.00 (0.0787)
b
1.80 (0.0709)
g
2.05 (0.0807)
c
1.85 (0.0729)
h
2.10 (0.0827)
d
1.90 (0.0748)
j
2.15 (0.0847)
e
1.95 (0.0768)
–
–
Q00299
Author:
Date:
1815
MX–15
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(b)
SST
Z01308
Using SST, remove the No.3 clutch hub with the synchronizer ring and 5th gear.
SST 09950–30010
14. REMOVE NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING AND SPACER
15. REMOVE REAR BEARING RETAINER
Using a torx socket wrench (T45), remove the 7 torx screws and
rear bearing retainer.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
16.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SNAP RING
Using a snap ring expander, remove the input shaft rear
bearing snap ring.
Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, remove the 2 snap
rings.
Q06190
17.
(a)
(b)
Q01615
18.
REMOVE STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG, SEAT, SPRING
AND LOCKING BALL
Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), remove the plug.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Using a magnetic finger, remove the seat, spring and
locking ball.
REMOVE REVERSE IDLER GEAR SHAFT LOCK BOLT
Sealant:
Part No. 08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
Q00056
Author:
Date:
1816
MX–16
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
19. REMOVE TRANSMISSION CASE
Remove the 17 bolts and tap the case with a plastic hammer.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826 – 00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
FIPG
Q05815
20. REMOVE SHIM
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Install the previously selected shim by adjusting output shaft
preload.
(See page MX–22)
MT0669
21.
SST
MT0693
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT REAR TAPER ROLLER
BEARING OUTER RACE
Using SST and a hammer, remove the output shaft rear taper
roller bearing outer race.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011)
22. REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL PIPE
(a) Remove the gasket from the oil pipe.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and oil pipe.
Torque: 17 N·m (175 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
23.
REMOVE REVERSE SHIFT ARM BRACKET ASSEMBLY
Remove the bolt and pull off the reverse shift arm and bracket.
Torque: 17 N·m (175 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
24. REMOVE REVERSE IDLER GEAR AND SHAFT
Pull out the shaft, and remove the reverse idler gear and thrust
washer.
Q06375
Matchmarks
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Align the matchmarks, as shown.
Z17557
Author:
Date:
1817
MX–17
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
25.
(a)
(b)
Q01614
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
REMOVE STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG, LOCKING BALL
AND SPRING
Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), remove the 2 plugs.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Using a magnetic finger, remove the 2 seats, springs and
balls.
26.
Q08124
REMOVE NO.1, NO.2 SHIFT FORKS AND SHIFT HEAD
SET BOLT
Torque: 24 N·m (240 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
27. REMOVE NO.1 SHIFT FORK SHAFT
Pull up the No.3 shift fork shaft, and remove the No.1 shift fork
shaft.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
When it is difficult to push the fork shaft through the reverse shift
fork, pull up the No.3 shift fork shaft.
28. REMOVE INTERLOCK ROLLER
Using a magnetic finger, remove the interlock roller from the reverse shift fork.
Q08125
29.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NO.2 SHIFT FORK SHAFT, SHIFT HEAD
AND NO.1 SHIFT FORK
Pull out the No.2 shift fork shaft.
Remove the shift head and No.1 shift fork.
Q08126
30.
(a)
(b)
31.
(a)
(b)
Z00182
REMOVE NO.3 SHIFT FORK SHAFT WITH REVERSE
SHIFT FORK AND NO.2 SHIFT FORK
Pull out the No.3 shift fork shaft with the reverse shift fork.
Remove the No.2 shift fork.
REMOVE SNAP RING
Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, remove the snap
ring and reverse shift fork from the No.3 shift fork shaft.
Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, remove the 3 snap
rings from the No.1, No.2 and No.3 shift fork shafts.
Author:
Date:
1818
MX–18
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
32.
(a)
(b)
33.
(a)
(b)
34.
35.
(a)
(b)
36.
(a)
MT0781
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
REMOVE INPUT AND OUTPUT SHAFTS ASSEMBLY
Leaning the output shaft to the differential side, remove
the input shaft assembly.
Lift up the differential case assembly, remove the output
shaft assembly.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
Remove the oil pump drive gear.
Remove the differential case assembly.
REMOVE MAGNET FROM TRANSAXLE CASE
REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
AND OIL PIPE
Remove the 2 bolts and oil pipe.
Torque: 17 N·m (175 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 bolts and oil pump assembly.
Torque: 17 N·m (175 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
REMOVE NO.5 SYNCHRONIZER RING WITH KEY
SPRING FROM NO.3 CLUTCH HUB
Remove the No.5 synchronizer ring with the key spring
from the No.3 clutch hub.
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b)
HINT:
Wrap vinyl tape on the screwdriver to prevent damaging the
synchronizer ring.
(c) Remove the synchronizer rings.
Author:
Date:
1819
MX–19
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MX054–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT NO.5 SYNCHRONIZER RING
Check for wear or damage.
Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. Turn the
middle No.5 synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the outer No.5 synchronizer ring. Check that the
ring locks.
If it does not lock, replace the synchronizer ring.
MT0782
2.
MEASURE SHIFT FORK AND HUB SLEEVE CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub
sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the shift fork or
hub sleeve.
WM0066
3.
(a)
(b)
SST
(c)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE INPUT SHAFT BEARING
AND OIL SEAL
Remove the 3 bolts and transaxle case receiver.
Using SST, pull out the bearing.
SST 09612–65014
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal.
Z00192
(d)
SST
(e)
Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09608–00081, 09950–70010 (09951–07150)
Coat the lip of seal with MP grease.
Z00194
(f)
SST
(g)
(h)
Using SST, drive in a new bearing.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00580), 09950–70010
(09951–07150)
Install the transaxle case receiver.
Install and torque the 3 bolts.
Torque: 7.4 N·m (75 kgf·cm, 65 in.·lbf)
Q08014
Author:
Date:
1820
MX–20
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(i)
Using SST and a press, remove the inner race.
SST 09950–00020
(j)
Using SST and a press, install a new input shaft front
bearing inner race.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00021)
4.
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
BEARING OUTER RACE AND OUTPUT SHAFT
FRONT COVER
Using SST, pull out the output shaft front bearing outer
race.
SST 09308–00010
Remove the output shaft cover.
SST
Q05164
SST
Q00141
SST
(a)
(b)
Q00338
(c) Install a new output shaft cover.
HINT:
Install the output shaft cover projection into the case side
groove.
Z00197
(d)
SST
SST
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new output shaft front
bearing outer race.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011, 09316–00021)
Q06368
Author:
Date:
1821
MX–21
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(e)
Using SST and a socket wrench, remove the output shaft
front bearing.
SST 09950–00020, 09950–00030
(f)
Using SST and a press, install a new output shaft front
bearing.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00071)
5.
(a)
(b)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE REVERSE RESTRICT PIN
Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), remove the screw plug.
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin.
Replace the reverse restrict pin.
Socket Wrench
SST
Q00245
SST
Z00199
(c)
Q01611
(d)
(e)
(f)
Z00201
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted spring
pin.
Apply sealant to the screw plug threads.
Sealant:
Part No. 08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Using a hexagon wrench (6 mm), install and torque the
screw plug.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1822
MX–22
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MX055–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
HINT:
Before reassembly, select a shim by adjusting output
shaft preload.
Coat all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil
before reassembly.
ADJUST OUTPUT SHAFT PRELOAD
(a) Install the output shaft assembly to the transaxle case.
(b) Install the transmission case to the transaxle case.
HINT:
If necessary, tap on the case with a plastic hammer.
(c) Install and torque the 17 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
(d) Install the output shaft rear taper roller bearing outer race.
(e) Install the adjusting shim.
HINT:
When reusing the output shaft bearing, first install a shim of the
same thickness as before. If installing a new taper roller bearing, first select and install a shim of lesser thickness than before.
(f)
Install the rear bearing retainer.
(g) Using a torx wrench (T45), install and torque the 7 torx
screws.
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
(h) Install a new lock nut to the output shaft.
(i)
Turn the output shaft right and left 2 or 3 times to allow the
bearing to settle.
Author:
Date:
1823
MX–23
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(j)
Z12593
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Preload (at starting):
New bearing
0.8 – 1.6 N·m (8 – 16 kgf·cm, 6.9 – 13.9 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing
0.5 – 1.0 N·m (5 – 10 kgf·cm, 4.3 – 8.7 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within the specification, select an appropriate adjusting shim.
The preload will change approx. 0.4 – 0.5 N·m (4 – 5 kgf·cm, 3.5
– 4.3 in.·lbf) for every 0.05 mm change in adjusting shim thickness.
(k)
(l)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
0
1.30 (0.0512)
D
1.95 (0.0768)
1
1.35 (0.0531)
E
2.00 (0.0787)
2
1.40 (0.0551)
F
2.05 (0.0807)
3
1.45 (0.0571)
G
2.10 (0.0827)
4
1.50 (0.0591)
H
2.15 (0.0846)
5
1.55 (0.0610)
J
2.20 (0.0866)
6
1.60 (0.0630)
K
2.25 (0.0886)
7
1.65 (0.0650)
L
2.30 (0.0906)
8
1.70 (0.0669)
M
2.35 (0.0925)
9
1.75 (0.0689)
N
2.40 (0.0945)
A
1.80 (0.0709)
P
2.45 (0.0965)
B
1.85 (0.0728)
Q
2.50 (0.0984)
C
1.90 (0.0748)
–
–
Remove the lock nut.
Remove these parts. Removal is in the reverse order of
installation.
Rear bearing retainer
Shim
Transmission case
Output shaft assembly
Output shaft rear bearing outer race
Author:
Date:
1824
MX–24
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
INPUT SHAFT
INPUT SHAFT
MX056–01
COMPONENTS
Spacer
Synchronizer Ring
4th Gear
Snap Ring
Needle Roller Bearing
3rd Gear
Needle Roller Bearing
Rear Bearing
Spring
Snap Ring
Input Shaft Front Bearing Inner Race
Synchronizer Ring
No.2 Hub Sleeve
No.2 Clutch Hub
Input Shaft
Shifting Key
Non–reusable part
MT0791
Author:
Date:
1825
MX–25
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
INPUT SHAFT
MX057–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
3rd Gear
4th Gear
Q06369
Q00111
MEASURE 3RD AND 4TH GEARS THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
3rd gear: 0.10 – 0.35 mm (0.0039 – 0.0138 in.)
4th gear: 0.10 – 0.55 mm (0.0039 – 0.0217 in.)
Maximum clearance:
3rd gear: 0.40 mm (0.0157 in.)
4th gear: 0.60 mm (0.0236 in.)
2.
CHECK 3RD AND 4TH GEARS RADIAL CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance between
the gear and shaft.
Standard clearance:
3rd gear: 0.009 – 0.053 mm (0.0004 – 0.0021 in.)
4th gear: 0.009 – 0.051 mm (0.0004 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum clearance:
3rd and 4th gears: 0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the gear,
needle roller bearing or shaft.
3.
REMOVE SNAP RING
Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the snap ring.
4.
REMOVE REAR BALL BEARING AND 4TH GEAR
Using SST and a press, remove the rear bearing.
SST 09950–00020
5.
REMOVE NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING, SPACER AND
SYNCHRONIZER RING
6.
REMOVE SNAP RING
Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the snap ring.
SST
Q05165
Author:
Date:
1826
MX–26
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
INPUT SHAFT
7.
REMOVE NO.2 CLUTCH HUB ASSEMBLY, SYNCHRONIZER RING AND 3RD GEAR
Using a press, remove the No.2 hub sleeve, 3rd gear and synchronizer rings.
8.
REMOVE NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
Q00115
Author:
Date:
1827
MX–27
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
INPUT SHAFT
MX058–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT 3RD GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING
Check for wear or damage.
Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. Turn the
synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the
gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If it does not lock, replace the synchronizer ring.
MT0780
(c)
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring.
MT0786
2.
(a)
(b)
WM0064
INSPECT 4TH GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING
Check for wear or damage.
Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. Turn the
synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the
gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, apply a small amount of the
fine lapping compound between the synchronizer ring and gear
cone. Lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone together.
NOTICE:
Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed
off after rubbing.
(c) Check again the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
(d)
WM0064
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring, and apply a small amount of the fine lapping compound on gear cone.
NOTICE:
Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed
off after rubbing.
Author:
Date:
1828
MX–28
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
INPUT SHAFT
3.
MEASURE NO.2 SHIFT FORK AND HUB SLEEVE
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub
sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the shift fork or
hub sleeve.
WM0066
C
B
A
4.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT INPUT SHAFT
Check the input shaft for wear or damage.
Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the input shaft journal surface.
Minimum outer diameter:
Part A: 27.950 mm (1.1004 in.)
Part B and C: 35.950 mm (1.4154 in.)
(c)
Using a dial indicator, check the shaft runout.
Maximum runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Q00172
Q00173
Author:
Date:
1829
MX–29
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
INPUT SHAFT
MX059–02
REASSEMBLY
Front
Q00383
HINT:
Coat all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil before
reassembly.
1.
INSTALL NO.2 CLUTCH HUB INTO HUB SLEEVE
(a) Install the 3 springs and shifting keys to the clutch hub.
(b) Install the hub sleeve to the clutch hub.
HINT:
Direct identification groove of the hub sleeve to front of the
transmission.
2.
INSTALL NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING, 3RD GEAR,
SYNCHRONIZER RING AND NO.2 HUB SLEEVE ASSEMBLY TO INPUT SHAFT
Apply MP grease to the needle roller bearing.
Assemble the needle roller bearings into the 3rd gear.
Place the synchronizer rings on the gear and align the
ring slots with the shifting keys.
(a)
(b)
(c)
MT0790
SST
(d)
Using SST and a press, install the 3rd gear and No.2 hub
sleeve.
SST 09506–35010
3.
(a)
INSTALL SNAP RING
Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial play.
Q00183
Q00116
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
H
2.30 (0.0906)
M
2.50 (0.0984)
J
2.35 (0.0925)
N
2.55 (0.1004)
K
2.40 (0.0945)
P
2.60 (0.1024)
L
2.45 (0.0965)
–
–
(b)
Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap in the snap ring.
Author:
Date:
1830
MX–30
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
N00494
MEASURE 3RD GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page MX–24)
5.
INSTALL SPACER, SYNCHRONIZER RING, NEEDLE
ROLLER BEARING, 4TH GEAR AND REAR BALL
BEARING
Install the spacer.
Apply MP grease to the needle roller bearings.
Place the synchronizer ring on the gear and align the ring
slots with the shifting keys.
Install the 4th gear.
Using SST and a press, install the rear ball bearing.
SST 09506–35010
INSTALL SNAP RING
Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial play.
(d)
(e)
6.
(a)
Q00116
INPUT SHAFT
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
SST
–
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
1
2.35 (0.0925)
5
2.55 (0.1004)
2
2.40 (0.0945)
6
2.60 (0.1024)
3
2.45 (0.0965)
7
2.65 (0.1043)
4
2.50 (0.0984)
8
2.70 (0.1063)
(b)
7.
Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap in the snap ring.
MEASURE 4TH GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page MX–24)
Author:
Date:
1831
MX–31
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
OUTPUT SHAFT
MX05A–01
COMPONENTS
Needle Roller Bearing
3rd Driven Gear
4th Driven Gear
Spacer
Needle Roller Bearing
2nd Gear
Spacer
No.1 Hub Sleeve
Shifting Key
Output Shaft Rear Bearing
Shifting Key Spring
Spacer
1st Gear
Synchronizer Ring
No.1 Clutch Hub
S
Output Shaft Front Bearing
Synchronizer Ring
Non–reusable part
Output Shaft
N00785
Author:
Date:
1832
MX–32
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
MX05B–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
1st Gear
2nd Gear
Q06370
Z00218
MEASURE 1ST AND 2ND GEARS THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
1st gear: 0.10 – 0.35 mm (0.0039 – 0.0138 in.)
2nd gear: 0.10 – 0.45 mm (0.0039 – 0.0177 in.)
Maximum clearance:
1st gear: 0.40 mm (0.0157 in.)
2nd gear: 0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
2.
CHECK 1ST AND 2ND GEARS RADIAL CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance between
the gear and shaft.
Standard clearance:
1st gear: 0.009 – 0.051 mm (0.0004 – 0.0020 in.)
2nd gear: 0.009 – 0.053 mm (0.0004 – 0.0021 in.)
Maximum clearance:
1st and 2nd gears: 0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the gear,
needle roller bearing or shaft.
3.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT REAR BEARING, 4TH
DRIVEN GEAR AND SPACER
(a) Using a press, remove the bearing and 4th driven gear.
(b) Remove the spacer.
Z00219
4.
REMOVE 3RD DRIVEN GEAR AND 2ND GEAR
Using a press, remove the 3rd driven gear and 2nd gear.
5.
REMOVE NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING, SPACER AND
SYNCHRONIZER RING
6.
REMOVE SNAP RING
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
Z00220
Author:
Date:
1833
MX–33
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
7.
REMOVE NO.1 HUB SLEEVE ASSEMBLY AND 1ST
GEAR
Using a press, remove the No.1 hub sleeve and 1st gear.
8.
REMOVE SYNCHRONIZER RING AND NEEDLE
ROLLER BEARING
Z00222
9.
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT BEARING
Using SST, remove the output shaft front bearing.
SST 09950–00020, 09950–00030
SST
Q00296
Author:
Date:
1834
MX–34
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
MX05C–02
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
WM0064
INSPECT 1ST GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING
Check for wear or damage.
Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. Turn the
synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the
gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, apply a small amount of the
fine lapping compound between the synchronizer ring and gear
cone. Lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone together.
NOTICE:
Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed
off after rubbing.
(c) Check again the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
(d)
WM0065
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring, and apply a small amount of the fine lapping compound on gear cone.
NOTICE:
Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed
off after rubbing.
2.
INSPECT 2ND GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING
(a) Check for wear or damage.
(b) Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. Turn the
synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the
gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If it does not lock, replace the synchronizer ring.
MT0780
(c)
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring.
MT0787
Author:
Date:
1835
MX–35
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
3.
MEASURE NO.1 SHIFT FORK AND HUB SLEEVE
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub
sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the shift fork or
hub sleeve.
WM0066
4.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT OUTPUT SHAFT
Check the output shaft for wear or damage.
Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the
output shaft journal surface.
Minimum outer diameter:
38.950 mm (1.5335 in.)
(c)
Using a dial indicator, check the shaft runout.
Maximum runout:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Z00223
Z00224
Author:
Date:
1836
MX–36
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
MX05D–01
REASSEMBLY
Front
Q00384
HINT:
Coat all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil before
reassembly.
1.
INSTALL NO.1 CLUTCH HUB INTO HUB SLEEVE
(a) Install the clutch hub and shifting keys to the hub sleeve.
(b) Install the shifting key springs under the shifting keys.
NOTICE:
Position the key springs so that their end gaps are not
aligned.
2.
INSTALL NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING, 1ST GEAR,
SYNCHRONIZER RING AND NO.1 HUB SLEEVE TO
OUTPUT SHAFT
Apply MP grease to the needle roller bearing.
Install the 1st gear.
Place the synchronizer ring (for the 1st gear) on the gear
and align the ring slots with the shifting keys.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Z00225
(d)
Using SST and a press, install the 1st gear and No.1 hub
sleeve.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00041)
3.
(a)
INSTALL SNAP RING
Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial play.
SST
Z00385
Z00386
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
A
2.80 (0.1102)
E
3.00 (0.1181)
B
2.85 (0.1122)
F
3.05 (0.1201)
C
2.90 (0.1142)
G
3.10 (0.1220)
D
2.95 (0.1161)
–
–
(b)
Thickness mm (in.)
Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
Author:
Date:
1837
MX–37
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
4.
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
MEASURE 1ST GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page MX–31)
5.
MT0792
INSTALL SPACER, NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING, SYNCHRONIZER RING, 2ND GEAR AND 3RD DRIVEN
GEAR
(a) Install the spacer.
(b) Apply MP grease to the needle roller bearing.
(c) Place the synchronizer rings (for the 2nd gear) on the
gear.
NOTICE:
Do not install the synchronizer ring for the 1st gear.
(d) Install the 2nd gear.
(e) Using a press, install the 3rd driven gear.
NOTICE:
Align the clutch hub grooves with the projections on the
synchronizer ring.
6.
MEASURE 2ND GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page MX–31)
N00495
7.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SPACER AND 4TH DRIVEN GEAR
Install the spacer.
Using a press, install the 4th driven gear.
Z00390
8.
INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT REAR BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the bearing.
SST 09506–30012
SST
Z00391
Author:
Date:
1838
MX–38
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
9.
INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT BEARING
Using SST and a press, install a new output shaft front bearing.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00071)
SST
Z00392
Author:
Date:
1839
MX–39
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OIL PUMP
OIL PUMP
MX05E–01
COMPONENTS
O–Ring
Gasket
Oil Strainer
Oil Pump Driven Rotor
10 (105, 8)
Transmission Oil
Pump Case
Oil Pump Drive Rotor
Oil Pump Drive Gear
Relief Valve
Ball
Spring
Spring Holder
Oil Pump Cover
10 (105, 8)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z17558
Author:
Date:
1840
MX–40
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
OIL PUMP
MX05F–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
CHECK ROTOR BODY CLEARANCE
Install the oil pump drive gear to the drive rotor.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the body clearance between the drive rotor and oil pump case.
Standard clearance:
0.10 – 0.16 mm (0.0039 – 0.0063 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
2.
(a)
(b)
CHECK ROTOR TIP CLEARANCE
Install the oil pump drive gear to the drive rotor.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the tip clearance between
the drive and driven rotors.
Standard clearance:
0.08 – 0.15 mm (0.0031 – 0.0059 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
Z00242
Z00243
3.
CHECK SIDE CLEARANCE
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the
side clearance of both rotors.
Standard clearance:
0.03 – 0.08 mm (0.0012 – 0.0031 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
Z00244
Author:
Date:
1841
MX–41
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
MX05G–02
COMPONENTS
Dust Boot
Oil Seal
Control Shaft Cover
Snap Ring
No.1 Compression Spring
Shift Interlock Plate
No.2 Shift Inner Lever
No.2 Select Spring Seat
No.1 Select Spring Seat
Slotted Spring Pin
Slotted Spring Pin
No.2 Compression Spring
Snap Ring
No.1 Shift Inner Lever
Shift and Select Lever Shaft
Non–reusable part
MP Grease
Q10276
Author:
Date:
1842
MX–42
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
MX05H–01
COMPONENTS
Transaxle Case Cover
Stud Bolt
54 (550, 40)
54 (550, 40)
Differential Spider
Oil Seal
Differential Pinion
Differential Side Gear
Side Gear Thrust
Washer
Pinion Thrust Washer
Tapered Roller Bearing
and Outer Race
63 (640, 46)
Differential Right Case
Vehicle Speed Sensor Drive Gear
x 16
Differential Left Case
Ring Gear
Tapered Roller Bearing and Outer Race
x 16
Shim
124 (1,260, 91)
Oil Baffle
Oil Seal
Z17560
Author:
Date:
1843
MX–43
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
MX05I–03
DISASSEMBLY
SST
Q05166
Matchmarks
1.
REMOVE TAPERED ROLLER BEARING
Using SST, remove the left and right bearings.
SST 09950–40011
2.
REMOVE RING GEAR
(a) Place matchmarks on both the differential case and ring
gear.
(b) Remove the 16 bolts.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, tap the ring gear and remove it.
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
DISASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Place matchmarks on the differential right and left cases.
Using a torx wrench (T50), remove the 16 torx screws.
Using a plastic hammer, tap the differential left case.
Remove the vehicle speed sensor drive gear from the differential right case.
(e)
Remove the 2 differential side gears, side gear thrust
washers, 4 differential pinions and pinion thrust washers
from the differential left case.
4.
Transmission Case Side:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OIL SEAL AND TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING OUTER RACE
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal.
Remove the oil baffle.
Using a brass bar and hammer, drive out the bearing outer race lightly and evenly.
Remove the shim.
Install the shim. (See page MX–42)
Z00281
Z00284
(a)
(b)
(c)
Z00286
(d)
(e)
HINT:
First select and install a shim of less thickness than before.
Author:
Date:
1844
MX–44
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
(f)
SST
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Using SST and a press, install a new tapered roller bearing outer race.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011, 09316–00041)
Z00288
(g) Install the oil baffle.
HINT:
Install the oil baffle projection into the case side cutout.
Z00289
(h)
SST
(i)
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09223–15020, 09950–70010 (09951–07150)
Coat the lip of oil seal with MP grease.
Q06288
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Transaxle Case Side:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OIL SEAL AND TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING OUTER RACE
Remove the 4 bolts and 3 nuts.
Using a plastic hammer, tap the stud bolt and remove the
transaxle case cover.
Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the oil seal
from the transaxle case cover.
MT0659
(d)
SST
Using SST, a brass bar and hammer, remove the tapered
roller bearing outer race.
SST 09612–65014
Z01427
Author:
Date:
1845
MX–45
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
SST
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(e)
Using SST and a press, install a new tapered roller bearing outer race.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011, 09316–00041)
(f)
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011)
Coat the oil seal lip with MP grease.
Z00292
(g)
SST
Z00293
(h)
FIPG
Z19038
(i)
F
(j)
(k)
Apply FIPG to the transaxle case cover, as shown.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826 – 00090, THREE BOND 1281 or
equivalent
Apply sealant to the bolt threads.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Install the stud bolt and cover to the transaxle case.
Install and torque the 4 bolts and 3 nuts.
Torque: 54 N·m (550 kgf·cm, 40 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1846
MX–46
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
MX05J–01
REASSEMBLY
Z00295
1.
ASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
HINT:
Coat all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil before
reassembly.
(a) Install the thrust washer to the side gear.
(b) Install the 4 pinions and thrust washers to the spider.
(c) Install the side gear and spider with the 4 pinions to the
differential left case.
(d) Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash of the pinion
gear while holding the differential left case.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
HINT:
Push the pinion gear and spider with the 4 pinions to the differential left case.
(e)
Install the side gear and spider with the 4 pinions to the
right side of the differential case. Check the side gear
backlash.
(f)
Refer to the table below, and select the thrust washer
which will ensure that the backlash is within the specification. Try to select a washer of the same size.
Z00296
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
0.80 (0.0315)
1.20 (0.0472)
0.90 (0.0354)
1.30 (0.0512)
1.00 (0.0394)
1.40 (0.0551)
1.10 (0.0433)
–
Z00297
(g)
Install the vehicle speed sensor drive gear.
Z00298
Author:
Date:
1847
MX–47
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
(h)
(i)
Matchmarks
(j)
2.
(a)
Z00299
(b)
(c)
(d)
Driven Gear
Side
Z00303
SST
SST
Q06410
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Align the matchmarks on the differential cases.
Using a plastic hammer, carefully tap the differential case
to install it.
Using a torx wrench (T50), install and torque the 16 torx
screws.
Torque: 63 N·m (640 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
INSTALL RING GEAR
Clean the contact surface of the differential case and the
threads of the ring gear and differential case.
Heat the ring gear in boiling water.
Carefully remove the ring gear from the water.
After the moisture on the ring gear has completely evaporated, quickly install the ring gear to the differential case.
HINT:
Align the matchmarks on the differential left case.
(e) Temporarily install the 16 bolts.
NOTICE:
The ring gear set bolts should not be tightened until the
ring gear has cooled sufficiently.
(f)
After the ring gear has cooled sufficiently, torque the ring
gear set bolts.
Torque: 124 N·m (1,260 kgf·cm, 91 ft·lbf)
3.
INSTALL TAPERED ROLLER BEARING
Using SST and a press, install new left and right bearings onto
the differential case.
SST 09316–20011, 09316–60011 (09316–00011)
HINT:
Press the bearing on the ring side first.
4.
ADJUST OUTPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY PRELOAD
(See pages MX–22)
5.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY TO
TRANSAXLE CASE
6.
INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Lift up the differential case and install the output shaft assembly.
7.
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CASE
(a) Install the transmission case.
HINT:
If necessary, tap on the case with a plastic hammer.
(b) Install and torque the 17 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm 22 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1848
MX–48
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
8.
INSTALL OUTPUT SHAFT REAR TAPERED ROLLER
BEARING OUTER RACE
Using a plastic hammer, drive in the outer race.
9.
INSTALL SHIM (See pages MX–22)
HINT:
Install the previously selected shim.
10. INSTALL REAR BEARING RETAINER
Using a torx wrench (T45), install and torque the 7 torx screws.
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
11.
Q00036
Z00309
ADJUST DIFFERENTIAL CASE SIDE BEARING PRELOAD
(a) Install a new lock nut to the output shaft.
(b) Turn the output shaft right and left 2 or 3 times to allow the
bearings to settle.
(c) Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Preload (at starting):
New bearing (Output shaft preload plus)
0.2 – 0.3 N·m (1.8 – 3.5 kgf·cm, 1.6 – 3.0 in.·lbf)
Reused bearing (Output shaft preload plus)
0.1 – 0.2 N·m (1.1 – 2.2 kgf·cm, 1.0 – 1.9 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within the specification, select an appropriate adjusting shim.
HINT:
The total preload will change by about 0.1 – 0.2 N·m (1 – 2
kgf·cm, 0.9 – 1.7 in.·lbf) with each 0.05 mm change in adjusting
shim thickness.
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
0
2.00 (0.0787)
9
2.45 (0.0965)
1
2.05 (0.0807)
A
2.50 (0.0984)
2
2.10 (0.0827)
B
2.55 (0.1004)
3
2.15 (0.0846)
C
2.60 (0.1024)
4
2.20 (0.0866)
D
2.65 (0.1043)
5
2.25 (0.0886)
E
2.70 (0.1063)
6
2.30 (0.0906)
F
2.75 (0.1083)
7
2.35 (0.0925)
G
2.80 (0.1102)
8
2.40 (0.0945)
H
2.85 (0.1122)
12. REMOVE REAR BEARING RETAINER
Using a torx wrench (T45), remove the 7 torx screws and rear
bearing retainer.
13. REMOVE SHIM
14. REMOVE TRANSMISSION CASE
(a) Remove the 17 bolts.
(b) Using a plastic hammer, tap the transmission case.
15. REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
16. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
Author:
Date:
1849
MX–49
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
–
SHIFT LEVER AND CONTROL CABLE
SHIFT LEVER AND CONTROL CABLE
MX05K–01
COMPONENTS
Shift Lever Knob
Center Console Upper Panel
Heater Control Assembly
Center Cluster
Finish Panel
Rear Console Box
Front Console Box
Shift Cable Grommet Retainer
Shift Cable
Grommet
Shift Cable Grommet
Retainer
Grommet
12 (120, 9)
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Clip
Clip
Clip
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Shift Lever Assembly
Clip
Shift Control Cable
Clip
Washer
Clip
Clip
Select Control Cable
Washer
Washer
Clip
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Q10281
Author:
Date:
1850
MX–1
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
MANUAL TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
MX04A–01
PRECAUTION
When working with FIPG material, you must observe the following items.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all the old FIPG material from the gasket surfaces.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
Clean both sealing surfaces with a non–residue solvent.
Apply FIPG in an approx. 1 mm (0.04 in.) wide bead along the sealing surface.
Parts must be assembled within 10 minutes of application. Otherwise, the FIPG material must
be removed and reapplied.
Author:
Date:
1851
MX–2
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
MX04B–04
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
N i
Noise
1. Oil (Level low)
2. Oil (Wrong)
3. Gear (Worn or damaged)
4. Bearing (Worn or damaged)
MX–4
MX–4
MX–9
MX
9
MX–9
Oil leakage
l k
1. Oil (Level too high)
2. Gasket (Damaged)
3. Oil seal (Worn or damaged)
4. O–ring (Worn or damaged)
MX–4
MX–9
MX–9
MX
9
MX–9
1. Control cable (Faulty)
2. Synchronizer
y
ring
g (Worn
(
or damaged)
g )
MX–43
MX–9
MX–20
MX–28
MX–9
MX–20
MX–28
Hard to shift or will not shift
3.
3 Shift key spring (Damaged)
J
Jumps
outt off gear
1. Locking ball spring (Damaged)
2. Shift fork (Worn)
3. Gear (Worn or damaged)
4. Bearing (Worn or damaged)
Author:
MX–9
MX–9
MX–9
MX
9
MX–9
Date:
1852
MX–3
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
MX04C–01
COMPONENTS
w/ Cruise Control:
Cruise Control Actuator
Control Cable
Hood
14 (145, 10)
13 (130, 9)
Clip
Clutch Line
6.9 (70, 61 in.·lbf)
RH Drive Shaft
Snap Ring
32 (330, 24)
Washer
Clutch Release Cylinder
12 (120, 9)
39 (400, 29)
Manifold Stay
Air Cleaner
Case Assembly
with Air Hose
Clip
Bracket
12 (120, 9)
Vehicle Speed Sensor
46 (470, 34)
Connector
Ground Cable
Starter
39 (400, 29)
RH Fender Apron
Seal
Hold–Down
Clamp
39 (400, 29)
RH Stiffener
Back–Up Light Switch
Connector
Plate
37 (380, 27)
Battery
64 (650, 47)
LH Stiffener Plate
Transaxle
37 (380, 27)
Manifold Stay
Rear End Plate with Oil Pan
42 (425, 31)
Insulator
Rear RH Suspension Member Brace
36 (370, 27)
Snap
Ring
64 (650, 47)
9.3 (95, 82 in.·lbf)
64 (650, 47)
PS Gear Assembly
No.1 Fuel Tube Protector
Steering Return Pipe
LH Fender Apron
Seal
181 (1,850, 134)
19 (195, 14)
32 (330, 24)
10 (100, 7)
LH Drive Shaft
Engine LH
Mounting Insulator
with Bracket
49 (500, 36)
181 (1,850, 134)
294 (3,000, 217)
Silver Bolt: 44 (450, 33)
Green Bolt: 66 (670, 48)
Suspension Member with
Lower Suspension Arm
Front RH Suspension
Member Brace
36 (370, 27)
181 (1,850, 134)
Silver Bolt: 44 (450, 33)
Green Bolt: 66 (670, 48)
Lock Cap
Cotter Pin
Cotter Pin
Rear LH Suspension Member Brace
Stabilizer Bar Link
Hole
Plug
66 (670, 48)
Front LH
Suspension
Member Brace
Hole
Plug
80 (820, 59)
33 (330, 24)
Gasket
RH Fender
Liner
56 (570, 41)
127 (1,300, 94)
39 (400, 29)
Gasket
Front Exhaust Pipe
62 (630, 46)
No.1 Exhaust Pipe
Support Bracket
Engine Rear Side Shutter Plate
33 (330, 24)
LH Fender Liner
19 (195, 14)
Exhaust Pipe Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Q09998
Author:
Date:
1853
MX–4
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
MX04D–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE HOOD
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Adjust the hood.
(See page BO–10)
2.
REMOVE BATTERY AND AIR CLEANER CASE ASSEMBLY WITH AIR HOSE
3.
(a)
(b)
Q09982
4.
(a)
(b)
5.
(a)
(b)
A
w/ Cruise Control:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Disconnect the cruise control actuator connector.
Remove the 3 bolts and cruise control actuator with the
bracket.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
REMOVE STARTER
Disconnect the connector and wire from the starter.
Remove the 2 bolts and starter.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
DISCONNECT CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER
Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the release cylinder.
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 set bolts of the clutch line bracket.
Torque:
Bolt A: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Bolt B: 6.9 N·m (70 kgf·cm, 61 in.·lbf)
B
Q09999
6.
DISCONNECT GROUND CABLE
Remove the set bolt of the ground cable from the transaxle.
Q10000
7.
REMOVE MANIFOLD STAY
Remove the 2 bolts and stay.
Torque: 42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
8.
DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR AND
BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH CONNECTORS
9.
DISCONNECT CONTROL CABLE
(a) Remove the 2 clips and washers.
(b) Remove the 2 clips from the cables.
Q10001
Author:
Date:
1854
MX–5
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
10.
14 mm Head
17 mm Head
Q10002
REMOVE 4 TRANSAXLE UPPER SIDE MOUNTING
BOLTS
Torque:
17 mm head: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
14 mm head: 46 N·m (470 kgf·cm, 34 ft·lbf)
11. REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
12. RAISE VEHICLE
NOTICE:
Make sure that the vehicle is securely supported.
13. REMOVE ENGINE REAR SIDE SHUTTER PLATE AND
LH AND RH FENDER APRON SEALS
14.
Oil Level
0 – 5 mm
Filler Plug
15.
Drain Plug
DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
Oil grade: API GL–4 or GL–5
Viscosity: SAE 75W–90
Capacity: 2.6 liters (2.7 US qts, 2.3 Imp. qts)
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
REMOVE LH AND RH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–16)
Q10003
16.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
Remove the 2 bolts, nut and exhaust pipe bracket.
Torque:
Bolt: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Nut: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
(b)
Remove the 3 nuts and gasket from the exhaust manifold.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 bolts, nuts and gasket.
Torque: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 set bolts of the No.1 exhaust pipe support
bracket.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Remove the front exhaust pipe.
Q10010
(c)
(d)
(e)
Q10004
Author:
Date:
1855
MX–6
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
17.
(a)
(b)
Q09989
(c)
(d)
(e)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
DISCONNECT PS GEAR ASSEMBLY FROM FRONT
SUSPENSION MEMBER
Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the stabilizer bar link
from the stabilizer bar.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Remove the 4 set bolts of the stabilizer bar bracket.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 bolts, nut and No.1 fuel tube protector.
Tie the PS gear assembly to the proper position with a
code or an equivalent to suspend the assembly securely.
Remove the 2 set bolts and nuts of the PS gear assembly.
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
Q09990
18.
REMOVE 3 ENGINE FRONT SIDE MOUNTING BOLTS
Torque:
Silver bolt: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 33 ft·lbf)
Green bolt: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
19.
REMOVE LH ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR WITH
BRACKET
Remove the 2 hole plugs, nuts and 3 bolts.
Torque:
Bolt: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
Nut: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
Lift up the transaxle and remove the left engine mounting
insulator with the bracket.
Q10005
(a)
(b)
Q10006
20.
Q10007
REMOVE HOLE PLUG AND 3 ENGINE REAR SIDE
MOUNTING NUTS
Torque: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
21. ATTACH ENGINE SLING DEVICE TO ENGINE HANGER
(See page EM–69)
22. DISCONNECT STEERING RETURN PIPE FROM
FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER
Remove the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1856
MX–7
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
23.
C
A
C
A
C
C
–
B
A A
B
Q10008
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION MEMBER WITH LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Remove the LH and RH fender liner set screws.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts, 4 nuts, front LH and RH suspension
member braces, rear LH and RH suspension member
braces and front suspension member with the lower suspension arm.
Torque:
Bolt A: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
Bolt B: 32 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Nut C: 36 N·m (370 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
24. JACK UP TRANSAXLE SLIGHTLY
Using a transmission jack, support the transaxle.
25. REMOVE LH STIFFENER PLATE
Remove the 3 bolts and LH stiffener plate.
Torque: 37 N·m (380 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Q10011
26.
Q10009
REMOVE REAR END PLATE WITH OIL PAN INSULATOR AND RH STIFFENER PLATE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and rear end plate with the oil pan insulator.
Torque: 9.3 N·m (95 kgf·cm, 82 in.·lbf)
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and manifold stay.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and RH stiffener plate.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
27. REMOVE TRANSAXLE
Lower the engine left side and remove the transaxle from the
engine.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Align the input shaft with the clutch disc and install the
transaxle to the engine.
Temporarily tighten the transaxle mounting bolts.
Author:
Date:
1857
MX–8
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE UNIT
MX04E–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page MX–4).
HINT:
Front wheel alignment (See page SA–4).
Do the road test.
Author:
Date:
1858
MX–9
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MX04F–02
COMPONENTS
Release Bearing
Retainer
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
Straight Screw Plug
13 (130, 9)
Vehicle
Speed Sensor
Shift and Select Lever
Assembly
Lock Ball
Assembly
Reverse
Restrict Pin 29 (300, 22)
Back–UP
Light Switch
7.4 (75, 65 in.·lbf)
37 (375, 27)
37 (380, 27)
44 (450, 33)
Slotted
Spring Pin
Selecting Bellcrank
Shim
Differential Side
Bearing Retainer
Transmission
x6
Case Protector
Release
Bearing
Boot
O–Ring
Transmission
Case
Gasket
Gasket
Clutch Release Fork
Release Fork Support
18 (185, 13)
Drain Plug
42 (430, 31)
x5
Rear Bearing Retainer
39 (400, 29)
Filler Plug
18 (185, 13)
x 17
49 (500, 36)
Lock Bolt
29 (300, 22)
Spacer
Lock Nut
123 (1,250, 90)
29 (300, 22)
Gasket
Snap Ring
Needle Roller Bearing
5th Driven Gear
5th Gear
No.3 Clutch Hub Assembly
N0.3 Hub Sleeve
No.3 Shift Fork
18 (185, 13)
Snap Ring
Transmission Case Cover
x8
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Precoated part
29 (300, 22)
Z19123
Author:
Date:
1859
MX–10
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Reverse Shift Fork
Interlock Pin
Transaxle Case
Oil Seal
No.1 Shift Fork
No.2 Shift Fork Shaft
No.2 Shift Fork
Transaxle Case
Receiver
7.4 (75, 65 in.·lbf)
No.1 Shift Head
No.1 Shift Fork Shaft
Differential Case Assembly
Input Shaft Front Bearing
Bearing Lock Plate
Input Shaft Assembly
Reverse Shift Arm
Output Shaft Assembly
18 (185, 13)
Reverse Idler Gear
and Shaft
Output Shaft Front Bearing
Output Shaft Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z18962
Author:
Date:
1860
MX–11
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MX04G–02
DISASSEMBLY
1.
2.
REMOVE RELEASE FORK AND BEARING
REMOVE BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 33 ft·lbf)
3.
REMOVE BOLT AND VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
4.
REMOVE RELEASE BEARING RETAINER
Remove the 3 bolts and retainer.
Torque: 7.4 N·m (75 kgf·cm, 65 in.·lbf)
5.
REMOVE SELECTING BELLCRANK
Remove the 2 bolts and selecting bellcrank.
Torque: 37 N·m (380 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
6.
(a)
(b)
FIPG
Z18142
7.
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CASE COVER
Remove the 8 bolts.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
Using a plastic hammer, tap the transmission case cover
and remove it.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826 – 00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
REMOVE LOCK BALL ASSEMBLY
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
REMOVE SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER ASSEMBLY
8.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Apply FIPG to the underside of the flanged portion of the control
shaft cover.
FIPG:
Part No. 08826 – 00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1861
MX–12
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE OUTPUT SHAFT LOCK NUT
Unstake the nut.
Engage the gear double meshing.
(c)
Rotate the lock nut clockwise and remove it.
Torque: 123 N·m (1,250 kgf·cm, 90 ft·lbf)
Q02530
Install
Remove
Q05696
HINT:
The lock nut has LH threads.
(d) Disengage the gear double meshing.
10. REMOVE NO.3 HUB SLEEVE AND NO.3 SHIFT FORK
(a) Remove the No.3 shift fork set bolt.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
(b) Remove the No.3 hub sleeve and No.3 shift fork.
11. REMOVE 5TH DRIVEN GEAR
Using SST, remove the 5th driven gear.
SST 09950–40011
SST
Q05200
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Using SST, install the 5th driven gear.
SST 09309–12020
SST
SST
Z00455
12. MEASURE 5TH GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.20 – 0.40 mm (0.0079 – 0.0157 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.45 mm (0.0177 in.)
Q02695
Author:
Date:
1862
MX–13
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
Q02696
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
13. MEASURE 5TH GEAR RADIAL CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance.
Standard clearance:
0.009 – 0.050 mm (0.0004 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the gear,
needle roller bearing or input shaft.
14. REMOVE NO.3 CLUTCH HUB AND 5TH GEAR
(a) Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the snap
ring.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial play.
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
13
2.20–2.25
(0.0866–0.0886)
21
2.60–2.65
(0.1024–0.1043)
14
2.25–2.30
(0.0886–0.0906)
22
2.65–2.70
(0.1043–0.1063)
15
2.30–2.35
(0.0906–0.0925)
23
2.70–2.75
(0.1063–0.1083)
16
2.35–2.40
(0.0925–0.0945)
24
2.75–2.80
(0.1083–0.1102)
17
2.40–2.45
(0.0945–0.0965)
25
2.80–2.85
(0.1102–0.1122)
18
2.45–2.50
(0.0965–0.0984)
26
2.85–2.90
(0.1122–0.1142)
19
2.50–2.55
(0.0984–0.1004)
27
2.90–2.95
(0.1142–0.1161)
20
2.55–2.60
(0.1004–0.1024)
–
–
(b)
Using SST and a socket wrench, remove the No.3 clutch
hub with the synchronizer ring.
SST 09950–30010
SST
Socket Wrench
Q02726
Author:
Date:
1863
MX–14
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Using SST and a press, install the No.3 clutch hub assembly.
SST 09612–22011
(c) Remove the 5th gear.
15. REMOVE NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
SST
Q02682
x5
Q05785
18.
x 17
x6
16. REMOVE REAR BEARING RETAINER
Remove the 5 bolts and retainer.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
17. REMOVE BEARING SNAP RING
Using a snap ring expander, remove the 2 snap rings.
HINT:
If it is difficult to remove and install the snap rings, pull up the
shafts.
Q05826
FIPG
REMOVE REVERSE IDLER GEAR SHAFT LOCK BOLT
AND GASKET
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
19. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE BEARING RETAINER
AND SHIM
Remove the 6 bolts, retainer and shim.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
20. REMOVE TRANSMISSION CASE
(a) Remove the 17 bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
(b) Using a plastic hammer, tap the transmission case and remove it.
FIPG:
Part No. 08833 – 00090, THREE BOND 1281 or equivalent
Q09474
Author:
Date:
1864
MX–15
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
21.
(a)
(b)
22.
(a)
(b)
23.
Q05827
24.
25.
26.
(a)
(b)
(c)
27.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Q03065
(d)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
REMOVE REVERSE IDLER GEAR AND SHAFT
Pull out the shaft.
Remove the idler gear and thrust washer.
REMOVE REVERSE SHIFT ARM
Shift the fork shaft into reverse.
Remove the 2 bolts and pull off the reverse shift arm.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
REMOVE NO.1 SHIFT FORK SHAFT, NO.1 SHIFT
HEAD, NO.1 AND NO.2 SHIFT FORKS, REVERSE
SHIFT FORK WITH INTERLOCK PIN, INPUT AND OUTPUT SHAFTS ASSEMBLY
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
REMOVE MAGNET FROM TRANSAXLE CASE
REMOVE NO.2 SHIFT FORK SHAFT
Using a hexagon wrench, remove the straight screw plug.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin.
Pull out the shaft.
SEPARATE NO.1 SHIFT FORK SHAFT, NO.1 SHIFT
HEAD, NO.1, NO.2 SHIFT FORKS AND REVERSE
SHIFT FORK
Mount the shift forks to the vise.
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin from the No.1 fork shaft.
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin from the No.1 fork shaft, as shown.
Separate the No.1 shift fork shaft, No.1 shift head, No.1
and No.2 shift forks and reverse shift fork.
Author:
Date:
1865
MX–16
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
28.
(a)
MT0781
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
REMOVE NO.5 SYNCHRONIZER RING WITH KEY
SPRING FROM NO.3 CLUTCH HUB
Remove the No.5 synchronizer ring with the key spring
from the No.3 clutch hub.
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring.
(b)
HINT:
Wrap vinyl tape on the screwdriver to prevent damaging the
synchronizer ring.
(c) Remove the synchronizer rings.
Author:
Date:
1866
MX–17
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MX05M–01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT NO.5 SYNCHRONIZER RING
(a) Check for wear or damage.
(b) Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
Turn the middle No.5 synchronizer ring in one direction while
pushing it to the outer No.5 synchronizer ring. Check that the
ring locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, replace the synchronizer ring.
2.
INSPECT NO.3 SHIFT FORK AND NO.3 HUB SLEEVE
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub
sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the shift fork or
hub sleeve.
WM0066
3.
SST
SST
(a)
(b)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE INPUT SHAFT FRONT
BEARING
Remove the 2 bolts and transaxle case receiver.
Using SST, pull out the bearing.
SST 09308–00010
Z00409
(c)
SST
SST
(d)
Using SST, press in a new bearing.
SST 09310–35010
Install the transaxle case receiver and torque the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.4 N·m (75 kgf·cm, 65 in.·lbf)
Z00410
4.
SST
SST
(a)
(b)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OUTPUT SHAFT FRONT
BEARING
Remove the bolt and bearing lock plate.
Using SST, pull out the bearing.
SST 09308–00010
Z00411
Author:
Date:
1867
MX–18
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
(c)
SST
(d)
SST
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Using SST, press in a new bearing.
SST 09310–35010
Install the bearing lock plate and torque the bolt.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Front
Z00593
5.
0 – 0.5mm
(a)
(b)
SST
(c)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE INPUT SHAFT FRONT OIL
SEAL
Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09608–00081, 09950–70010 (09951–07150)
Drive in depth:
0 – 0.5 mm (0 – 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
Z00413
6.
(a)
(b)
13.5 ± 0.5mm
(c)
(d)
Z00596
(e)
(f)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE REVERSE RESTRICT PIN
Using a hexagon wrench, remove the straight screw plug.
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted
spring pin.
Replace the reverse restrict pin.
Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted spring
pin.
Drive in depth:
13.5 ± 0.5 mm (0.531 ± 0.020 in.)
Apply sealant to the plug threads.
Sealant:
Part No.08833 – 00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Using a hexagon wrench, install and torque the straight
screw plug.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1868
MX–19
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
MX04I–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page MX–11).
HINT:
Coat all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil before reassembly.
Author:
Date:
1869
MX–20
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
INPUT SHAFT
INPUT SHAFT
MX04J–01
COMPONENTS
Spacer
Needle Roller Bearing
4th Gear
Rear Bearing
Snap Ring
Synchronizer Ring
Synchronizer Ring
Shifting Key
No.2 Clutch Hub
Input Shaft
Snap Ring
3rd Gear
Needle Roller Bearing
No.2 Hub Sleeve
Key Spring
Q02560
Author:
Date:
1870
MX–21
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
INPUT SHAFT
MX04K–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
3rd Gear
4th Gear
Q05793
INSPECT 3RD AND 4TH GEARS THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance:
3rd gear: 0.10 – 0.25 mm (0.0039 – 0.0098 in.)
4th gear: 0.20 – 0.45 mm (0.0079 – 0.0177 in.)
Maximum clearance:
3rd gear: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
4th gear: 0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
2.
Z00417
INSPECT 3RD AND 4TH GEARS RADIAL CLEARANCES
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance between
the gear and shaft.
Standard clearance:
0.009 – 0.053 mm (0.0004 – 0.0021 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the gear,
needle roller bearing or shaft.
3.
REMOVE SNAP RING
Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the snap ring.
4.
SST
Q05201
REMOVE REAR BEARING, 4TH GEAR, NEEDLE
ROLLER BEARING, SPACER AND SYNCHRONIZER
RING FROM INPUT SHAFT
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the 4th gear and rear
bearing.
SST 09950–00020
(b) Remove the needle roller bearings, spacer and synchronizer ring.
5.
REMOVE SNAP RING
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
Author:
Date:
1871
MX–22
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
INPUT SHAFT
6.
SST
CM0064
REMOVE NO.2 HUB SLEEVE ASSEMBLY, 3RD GEAR
SYNCHRONIZER RING AND NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
Using SST and a press, remove the No.2 hub sleeve, 3rd gear,
synchronizer ring and needle roller bearings.
SST 09950–00020
NOTICE:
Be careful not to mistake the 3rd gear synchronizer ring for
the 4th gear synchronizer ring.
7.
REMOVE NO.2 HUB SLEEVE, SHIFTING KEY AND
SPRING FROM NO.2 CLUTCH HUB
Using a screwdriver, remove the 3 shifting keys and 2 springs
from the No.2 clutch hub.
SM0269
Author:
Date:
1872
MX–23
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
INPUT SHAFT
MX04L–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
WM0064
INSPECT SYNCHRONIZER RING
Check for wear or damage.
Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. Turn the
synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the
gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, apply a small amount of the
fine lapping compound between the synchronizer ring and gear
cone. Lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone together.
NOTICE:
Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed
off after rubbing.
(c) Check again the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
(d)
WM0065
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring, and apply a small amount of the fine lapping compound on gear cone.
NOTICE:
Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed
off after rubbing.
2.
INSPECT NO.2 SHIFT FORK AND HUB SLEEVE
CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub
sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace shift fork or hub
sleeve.
WM0066
Author:
Date:
1873
MX–24
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
A
B
C
–
INPUT SHAFT
3.
(a)
(b)
D
SM0182
INSPECT INPUT SHAFT
Check the input shaft for wear or damage.
Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the input shaft journal surface.
Minimum outer diameter:
Part A: 26.970 mm (1.0618 in.)
Part B: 32.470 mm (1.2783 in.)
Part C: 33.090 mm (1.3028 in.)
Part D: 29.970 mm (1.1799 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum, replace the input
shaft.
(c)
Using a dial indicator, check the shaft runout.
Maximum runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the runout exceeds the maximum, replace the input shaft.
CM0013
Author:
Date:
1874
MX–25
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
INPUT SHAFT
MX04M–01
REASSEMBLY
Engine
Side
SM0282
HINT:
Coat all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil before
reassembly.
1.
INSTALL NO.2 CLUTCH HUB INTO HUB SLEEVE
(a) Install the clutch hub and shifting keys to the hub sleeve.
(b) Install the shifting key springs under the shifting keys.
NOTICE:
Position the key springs so that their end gaps are not
aligned.
2.
INSTALL 3RD GEAR, NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING,
SYNCHRONIZER RING AND NO.2 HUB SLEEVE ASSEMBLY TO INPUT SHAFT
(a) Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearings.
(b) Place the synchronizer ring (for the 3rd gear) on the gear
and align the ring slots with the shifting keys.
NOTICE:
Do not install the synchronizer ring for 4th gear.
SM0193
(c)
Using a press, install the 3rd gear and No.2 hub sleeve.
3.
(a)
INSTALL SNAP RING
Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial play.
Z00419
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
1
1.95–2.00 (0.0768–0.0787)
2
2.00–2.05 (0.0787–0.0807)
3
2.05–2.10 (0.0807–0.0827)
4
2.10–2.15 (0.0827–0.0846)
5
2.15–2.20 (0.0846–0.0866)
6
2.20–2.25 (0.0866–0.0886)
Z00604
Author:
Date:
1875
MX–26
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
INPUT SHAFT
(b)
4.
Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
INSPECT 3RD GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page MX–20)
5.
INSTALL SYNCHRONIZER RING, NEEDLE ROLLER
BEARING, SPACER, 4TH GEAR AND REAR BALL
BEARING
Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearings.
Install the spacer and needle roller bearings.
(a)
(b)
SM0189
(c) Place the synchronizer ring on the gear.
HINT:
Align the ring slots with the shifting keys and the ring projections
with the hub slots.
SM0190
(d)
Using SST and a press, install the rear ball bearing.
SST 09608–00071
6.
(a)
INSTALL SNAP RING
Select a snap ring that allows the minimum axial play.
SST
SM0049
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
A
2.15–2.20 (0.0846–0.0866)
B
2.20–2.25 (0.0866–0.0886)
C
2.25–2.30 (0.0886–0.0906)
D
2.30–2.35 (0.0906–0.0925)
E
2.35–2.40 (0.0925–0.0945)
SM0050
(b)
Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap in the snap ring.
Author:
Date:
1876
MX–27
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
7.
–
INPUT SHAFT
INSPECT 4TH GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page MX–20)
Author:
Date:
1877
MX–28
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
OUTPUT SHAFT
MX04N–01
COMPONENTS
Output Shaft
Spacer
1st Gear
Needle Roller Bearing
Synchronizer Ring
No.1 Hub Sleeve
Shifting Key
Shifting Key Spring
No.1 Clutch Hub
Needle Roller Bearing
Ball
Spacer
Rear Bearing
Synchronizer Ring
2nd Gear
2nd Gear Bushing
3rd Driven Gear
4th Driven Gear
Author:
Q02544
Date:
1878
MX–29
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
MX04O–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
2nd Gear
1st Gear
Q05794
INSPECT 1ST AND 2ND GEARS THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the thrust clearance.
Standard clearance:
1st gear: 0.10 – 0.29 mm (0.0039 – 0.0114 in.)
2nd gear: 0.20 – 0.44 mm (0.0079 – 0.0173 in.)
Maximum clearance:
1st gear: 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
2nd gear: 0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
2.
SM0137
SST
INSPECT 1ST AND 2ND GEARS RADIAL CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance between
the gear and shaft.
Standard clearance:
0.009 – 0.053 mm (0.0004 – 0.0021 in.)
Maximum clearance:
0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the gear,
needle roller bearing or shaft.
3.
REMOVE REAR BALL BEARING, 4TH DRIVEN GEAR
AND OUTPUT GEAR SPACER
(a) Using SST and a press, remove the rear ball bearing and
4th driven gear.
SST 09950–00020
(b) Remove the output gear spacer and ball.
CM0065
4.
SST
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE 3RD DRIVEN GEAR, 2ND GEAR, NEEDLE
ROLLER BEARING AND SYNCHRONIZER RING
Shift the No.1 hub sleeve into the 1st gear.
Using SST and a press, remove the 3rd driven gear and
2nd gear.
SST 09950–00020
Remove the needle roller bearing and synchronizer rings.
MT0063
Author:
Date:
1879
MX–30
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
REMOVE NO.1 HUB SLEEVE ASSEMBLY, 1ST GEAR,
SYNCHRONIZER RING, NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING,
THRUST WASHER AND LOCKING BALL
Using a press, remove the No.1 hub sleeve, 1st gear and
synchronizer ring.
Remove the needle roller bearing and locking ball.
Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the thrust
washer.
Z00427
6.
REMOVE NO.1 HUB SLEEVE, 3 SHIFTING KEYS AND
SPRINGS FROM NO.1 CLUTCH HUB
Q02948
Author:
Date:
1880
MX–31
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
MX04P–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
WM0064
INSPECT 1ST GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING
Check for wear or damage.
Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. Turn the
synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the
gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, apply a small amount of the
fine lapping compound between the synchronizer ring and gear
cone. Lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone together.
NOTICE:
Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed
off after rubbing.
(c) Check again the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
(d)
WM0065
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and the gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring, and apply a small amount of the fine lapping compound on gear cone.
NOTICE:
Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed
off after rubbing.
2.
INSPECT 2ND GEAR SYNCHRONIZER RING
(a) Check for wear or damage.
(b) Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
Turn the synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing
it to the gear cone. Check that the ring locks.
If the braking effect is insufficient, replace the synchronizer ring.
MT0780
(c)
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the synchronizer ring back and gear spline end.
Minimum clearance:
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring.
MT0787
Author:
Date:
1881
MX–32
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
3.
INSPECT SHIFT FORK AND HUB SLEEVE CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub
sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum clearance:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, replace the shift fork or
hub sleeve.
WM0066
4.
(a)
A
B
C
CM0014
INSPECT OUTPUT SHAFT
Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the
output shaft journal surface.
Minimum outer diameter:
Part A: 31.970 mm (1.2587 in.)
Part B: 37.970 mm (1.4949 in.)
Part C: 31.990 mm (1.2594 in.)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum, replace the output shaft.
(b)
Using a dial indicator, check the shaft runout.
Maximum runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the runout exceeds the maximum, replace the output shaft.
CM0015
Author:
Date:
1882
MX–33
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
MX04Q–01
REASSEMBLY
Front
Q02949
HINT:
Coat all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil before
reassembly.
1.
INSTALL NO.1 CLUTCH HUB INTO HUB SLEEVE
(a) Install the 3 springs and shifting keys to the clutch hub.
(b) Install the hub sleeve to the clutch hub.
HINT:
Position the identification groove of the hub sleeve to the front
of the transmission.
2.
(a)
SST
(b)
INSTALL THRUST WASHER, 1ST GEAR, NEEDLE
ROLLER BEARING, SYNCHRONIZER RING AND NO.1
HUB SLEEVE TO OUTPUT SHAFT
Using SST and a press, install the thrust washer.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00041)
Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearing.
SM0199
(c)
Place the synchronizer ring on the gear and align the ring
slots with the shifting keys.
(d)
3.
Using a press, install the 1st gear and No.1 hub sleeve.
INSPECT 1ST GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page MX–28)
Z00428
Z00429
Author:
Date:
1883
MX–34
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
OUTPUT SHAFT
4.
MT0792
INSTALL SYNCHRONIZER RING, 2ND GEAR,
NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING AND 3RD DRIVEN GEAR
(a) Install the ball.
(b) Fit the 2nd gear bushing groove securely over the ball
when installing the 2nd gear bushing on the shaft.
(c) Place the synchronizer rings on the 2nd gear.
(d) Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearing and install it.
(e) Install the 2nd gear.
NOTICE:
Align the clutch hub grooves with the projections on the
synchronizer ring.
(f)
5.
SST
Using SST and a press, install the 3rd driven gear.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011)
INSPECT 2ND GEAR THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page MX–28)
SM0201
6.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL OUTPUT GEAR SPACER, 4TH DRIVEN
GEAR AND RADIAL BALL BEARING
Install the outer gear spacer.
Using a press, install the 4th driven gear and bearing.
Z00431
7.
INSTALL REAR BEARING
Using SST and a press, install the rear bearing.
SST 09612–22011
SST
SM0202
Author:
Date:
1884
MX–35
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
SHIFT AND SELECT LEVER SHAFT
MX04R–01
COMPONENTS
Shift and Select Lever Shaft
E–Ring
Select Spring Seat
Compression Spring
Shift Interlock Plate
6.4 (85, 56 in.·lbf)
Compression Spring
Dust Boot
Washer
E–Ring
Slotted Spring Pin
Shift Inner Lever No.1
Shift Inner Lever No.2
Select Spring Seat No.2
Lever Lock Pin
Oil Seal
Control Shaft Lever
Control Shaft Cover
O–Ring
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
MP Grease
Q10277
Author:
Date:
1885
MX–36
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
MX04S–01
COMPONENTS
Shim
Outer Race and Side Bearing
Pinion Thrust Washer
Ring Gear
Pinion Gear
Pinion Shaft
83 (850, 61)
x8
Side Bearing and Outer Race
Side Gear
Shim
Side Gear Thrust Washer
Differential Case
Straight Pin
Vehicle Speed Sensor Drive Gear
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z19302
Author:
Date:
1886
MX–37
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
MX04T–01
DISASSEMBLY
SST
1.
(a)
Q08148
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Vehicle Speed Sensor Drive Gear Side:
REMOVE SIDE BEARING FROM DIFFERENTIAL
CASE
Using SST, remove the bearing from the drive gear side
of the case.
SST 09950–00020, 09950–00030
Remove the vehicle speed sensor drive gear.
REMOVE RING GEAR
Place matchmarks on the ring gear and case.
Remove the 8 bolts.
Using a copper hammer, tap on the ring gear to remove
it from the case.
3.
SST
Ring Gear Side:
REMOVE SIDE BEARING FROM DIFFERENTIAL
CASE
Using SST, remove the bearing from the ring gear side of the
case.
SST 09950–00020, 09950–00030
Q04969
AT2799
4.
INSPECT SIDE GEAR BACKLASH
Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash of one side gear
while holding one pinion toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, install the correct
thrust washer to the side gears.
5.
DISASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the straight pin.
(b) Remove the pinion shaft from the case.
(c) Remove the 2 pinions and side gears with the 4 thrust
washers from each gear.
Author:
Date:
1887
MX–38
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
6.
(a)
SST
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Transaxle Case Side:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE DIFFERENTIAL SIDE
BEARING RETAINER OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive out the oil seal from the
retainer.
SST 09950–60020 (09951–00680), 09950–70010
(09951–07150)
Q08145
(b)
(c)
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the case surface.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 09351–32150)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST
SM0286
7.
(a)
(b)
SST
(c)
Transmission Case Side:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SIDE OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the oil seal.
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the case surface.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 09351–32150)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SM0155
8.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Transaxle Case Side:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SIDE BEARING OUTER
RACE
Using a brass bar and hammer, drive out the bearing outer race.
Install the bearing retainer without an O–ring.
Install and torque the 6 bolts.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Z00442
(d)
(e)
SST
(f)
(g)
Place the thinnest shim into the case.
Using SST and a press, install a new bearing outer race.
SST 09950–60020 (09951–00680), 09950–70010
(09951–07150)
Remove the 6 bolts.
Remove the bearing retainer and shim.
MT0634
Author:
Date:
1888
MX–39
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
SST
Q08184
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Transaxle Case Side:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SIDE BEARING OUTER
RACE
Using a brass bar and hammer, drive out the bearing outer race and shim.
Place the shim into the case.
Using SST and a press, install a new bearing outer race.
SST 09950–60020 (09951–00680), 09950–70010
(09951–07150)
Author:
Date:
1889
MX–40
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
MX04U–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
ASSEMBLE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Install the correct thrust washers and side gears. Refer to
the table below, select thrust washers which will ensure
that the backlash is within the specification. Try to select
washers of the same size for both sides.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
Thickness mm (in.)
0.95 (0.0374)
1.10 (0.0433)
1.00 (0.0394)
1.15 (0.0453)
1.05 (0.0413)
1.20 (0.0472)
Install the thrust washers and side gears in the differential
case.
Install the pinion shaft.
(c)
AT2981
Inspect the side gear backlash.
Using a dial indicator, measure the side gear backlash
while holding one pinion gear toward the case.
Standard backlash:
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
If the backlash is not within the specification, install a thrust
washer of different thickness.
(d) Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the straight pin
through the case and hole in the pinion shaft.
(e) Stake the differential case.
2.
INSTALL RING GEAR ON DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Clean the contact surface of the differential case and the
threads of the ring gear and differential case.
(b) Heat the ring gear in boiling water.
(c) Carefully take the ring gear out of the water.
(d) After moisture on the ring gear has completely evaporated, quickly install the ring gear to the differential case.
HINT:
Align the matchmarks on the differential case and the ring gear.
(e) Temporarily install the 8 bolts.
NOTICE:
The ring gear set bolts should not be torqued until the ring
gear has cooled sufficiently.
(f)
After the ring gear has cooled sufficiently, torque the ring
gear set bolts.
Torque: 83 N·m (850 kgf·cm, 61 ft·lbf)
Q08147
Author:
Date:
1890
MX–41
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
3.
(a)
INSTALL SIDE BEARING TO DIFFERENTIAL CASE
Using SST and a press, install a new side bearing to the
transmission case side.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011), 09350–32014
(09351–32120)
(b)
Install the vehicle speed sensor drive gear to the transaxle case side.
SST
SM0287
Case Side
Q08649
(c)
SST
SM0289
Using SST and a press, install a new side bearing to the
transaxle case side.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011), 09350–32014
(09351–32120)
NOTICE:
Install the black cage bearing on the vehicle speed sensor
drive gear side.
4.
ADJUST DIFFERENTIAL CASE SIDE BEARING PRELOAD
(a) Install the differential to the transaxle case.
(b) Install the transmission case.
(c) Install and torque the case bolts.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
(d) Install the shim into the transmission case.
(e) Install the bearing retainer without an O–ring.
(f)
Install and torque the 6 bolts.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1891
MX–42
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(g)
SST
Z00620
Using SST and a torque wrench, measure the preload.
SST 09564–32011
Preload (at starting):
0.8 – 1.6 N·m (8 – 16 kgf·cm, 6.9 – 13.9 in.·lbf)
If the preload is not within the specification, remove the transmission case side bearing retainer. Select another shim.
HINT:
The preload will change about 0.3 – 0.4 N·m (3 – 4 kgf·cm, 2.6
– 3.5 in.·lbf) with each 0.05 mm (0.0019 in.) change in shim
thickness.
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
Mark
Thickness mm (in.)
1
1.90 (0.0748)
11
2.40 (0.0945)
2
1.95 (0.0768)
12
2.45 (0.0965)
3
2.00 (0.0787)
13
2.50 (0.0984)
4
2.05 (0.0807)
14
2.55 (0.1004)
5
2.10 (0.0827)
15
2.60 (0.1024)
6
2.15 (0.0846)
16
2.65 (0.1043)
7
2.20 (0.0866)
17
2.70 (0.1063)
8
2.25 (0.0886)
18
2.75 (0.1083)
9
2.30 (0.0906)
19
2.80 (0.1102)
10
2.35 (0.0925)
–
–
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Remove
Remove
Remove
Remove
the
the
the
the
6 bolts.
bearing retainer and shim.
17 bolts.
transmission case.
Author:
Date:
1892
MX–43
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
–
SHIFT LEVER AND CONTROL CABLE
SHIFT LEVER AND CONTROL CABLE
MX04V–02
COMPONENTS
Shift Lever Knob
Center Console Upper Panel
Heater Control Assembly
Center Cluster
Finish Panel
Rear Console Box
Front Console Box
Shift Cable Grommet Retainer
Shift Cable Grommet
Retainer
Shift Cable
Grommet
Grommet
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Clip
Clip
12 (120, 9)
Clip
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Shift Lever Assembly
Clip
Shift Control Cable
Clip
Washer
Clip
Clip
Select Control Cable
Washer
Washer
Clip
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Q10340
Author:
Date:
1893
ST–1
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTING SYSTEM
STARTING SYSTEM
ST03H–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
Before changing the starter, check the following items again:
Connector connection
Accessory installation, e.g.: theft deterrent system
Author:
Date:
1708
ST–2
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
STARTER
ST03I–04
COMPONENTS
Hold Down Clamp
Battery
Throttle Cable
Clamp (A/T)
Battery Tray
Cruise Control
Cover
Cruise
Control
Actuator
Connector
Starter
Clamp
Starter Cable
Starter Connector
Cruise Control Actuator
B01153
Author:
Date:
1709
ST–3
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
Snap Ring
Starter Housing
Stop Collar
Pinion Gear
Compression Spring
Spring Retainer
Starter Clutch
Compression Spring
Starter Housing and
Clutch Assembly
Clutch Shaft
Idler Gear
Bearing
Steel Ball
Front Bearing
Return
Spring
Magnetic Switch
Assembly
Armature
Rear Bearing
O–Ring
Field Frame
(Field Coil)
O–Ring
Brush Holder
End Cover
Dust Protector
Non–reusable part
B01154
Author:
Date:
1710
ST–4
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
Magnetic Switch Assembly
Terminal Insulator
Terminal C Kit part
Contact Plate
Terminal Nut
17 (173, 13)
Terminal
Bolt
Wave Washer
Terminal Insulator
O–Ring
End Cover
Gasket
Plunger
Lead Terminal
O–Ring
Packing
Terminal Bolt
Terminal Insulator
Wave Washer
Terminal Nut
17 (173, 13)
Contact Plate
Terminal 30 Kit Part
Terminal Insulator
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06418
Author:
Date:
1711
ST–5
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
ST03J–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE BATTERY AND TRAY
w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Disconnect the actuator connector and clamp.
Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the actuator with the bracket.
REMOVE STARTER
Disconnect the starter connector.
Remove the 2 bolts, throttle cable clamp (A/T) and starter.
Remove the nut, and disconnect the starter cable.
Torque: 37 N·m (380 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1712
ST–6
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
ST03K–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE DUST PROTECTOR
REMOVE FIELD FRAME AND ARMATURE
Remove the nut, and disconnect the lead wire from the
magnetic switch terminal.
Torque: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in.·lbf)
Remove the 2 through bolts.
Torque: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in.·lbf)
B01156
Protrusion
Identation
(c) Pull out the field frame together with the armature.
HINT:
Align the protrusion of the field frame with the identation of the
magnetic switch.
(d) Remove the O–ring from the field frame.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to following items. Use
a new O–ring.
B01157
3.
(a)
REMOVE STARTER HOUSING, CLUTCH
ASSEMBLY AND GEAR
Remove the 2 screws.
Torque: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in.·lbf)
B01158
(b)
(1)
(4)
(3)
(2)
Remove these parts from the magnetic switch:
(1) Starter housing and clutch assembly
(2) Return spring
(3) Idler gear
(4) Bearing
B01160
4.
REMOVE STEEL BALL
Using a magnetic finger, remove the steel ball from the clutch
shaft hole.
B01159
Author:
Date:
1713
ST–7
STARTING (5S–FE)
5.
(a)
(b)
–
STARTER
REMOVE BRUSH HOLDER
Remove the 2 screws and end cover from the field frame.
Torque: 1.5 N·m (15 kgf·cm, 13 in.·lbf)
Remove the O–ring from the field frame.
B01161
(c)
Using a screwdriver, hold the spring back and disconnect
the brush from the brush holder. Disconnect the 4
brushes, and remove the brush holder.
NOTICE:
Check that the positive (+) lead wires are not grounded.
6.
REMOVE ARMATURE FROM FIELD FRAME
P13528
Author:
Date:
1714
ST–8
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
ST03L–03
INSPECTION
Ohmmeter
1.
(a)
INSPECT ARMATURE COIL
Check the commutator for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the segments of the commutator.
If there is no continuity between any segment, replace the armature.
Continuity
P10584
(b)
Check the commutator for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the commutator and armature coil core.
If there is continuity, replace the armature.
2.
INSPECT COMMUTATOR
(a) Check the commutator for the dirty and burnt surfaces.
If the surface is dirty or burnt, correct it with sandpaper (No.400)
or on a lathe.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P10585
(b)
Check for the commutator circle runout.
(1) Place the commutator on V–blocks.
(2) Using a dial gauge, measure the circle runout.
Maximum circle runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, correct it on a lathe.
P10586
(c)
Using vernier calipers, measure the commutator diameter.
Standard diameter: 30.0 mm (1.181 in.)
Minimum diameter: 29.0 mm (1.142 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the armature.
P10587
(d)
Check that the undercut depth is clean and free of foreign
materials. Smooth out the edge.
Standard undercut depth: 0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
Minimum undercut depth: 0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
If the undercut depth is less than minimum, correct it with a
hacksaw blade.
ST0040
Author:
Date:
1715
ST–9
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
3.
(a)
INSPECT FIELD COIL
Check the field coil for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the lead wire and field coil brush lead.
If there is no continuity, replace the field frame.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
P10588
(b)
Check the field coil for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the field coil end and field frame.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the field frame.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P10589
4.
INSPECT BRUSHES
Using vernier calipers, measure the brush length.
Standard length: 15.5 mm (0.610 in.)
Minimum length: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
If the length is less than minimum, replace the brush holder and
field frame.
Brush Holder Side
Length
Field Flame Side
Length
Z10079
5.
INSPECT BRUSH SPRINGS
Check the brush spring load.
Take the pull scale reading the instant the brush spring
separates from the brush.
Standard spring installed load:
1.2 kW
13.7 – 19.6 N (1.4 – 2.0 kgf, 3.0 – 4.4 lbf)
1.4 kW
17.6 – 23.5 N (1.8 – 2.4 kgf, 3.9 – 5.3 lbf)
Minimum spring installed load:
ST0019
1.2 kW
9.8 N (1.0 kgf, 2.2 lbf)
1.4 kW
11.8 N (1.2 kgf, 2.6 lbf)
If the installed load is less than minimum, replace the brush
springs.
Author:
Date:
1716
ST–10
STARTING (5S–FE)
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P13481
–
STARTER
6.
INSPECT BRUSH HOLDER
Check the brush holder insulation.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the positive (+) and negative (–) brush holders.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the brush holder.
7.
INSPECT CLUTCH AND GEAR
(a) Check the gear teeth on the pinion gear, idler gear and
clutch assembly for wear or damage.
If damaged, replace the gear or clutch assembly.
If damaged, also check the ring gear of the flywheel/drive plate
for wear or damage.
(b)
Check the clutch pinion gear.
Hold the starter clutch and rotate the pinion gear counterclockwise, and check that it turns freely. Try to rotate the
pinion gear clockwise and check that it locks.
If necessary, replace the clutch assembly.
Lock
Free
B01162
Ohmmeter
Terminal C
8.
(a)
INSPECT MAGNETIC SWITCH
Check the pull–in coil for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals 50 and C.
If there is no continuity, check and replace the magnetic switch.
Continuity
Terminal 50
B01163
(b)
Ohmmeter
Continuity
Terminal 50
Check the hold–in coil for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminal 50 and the switch body.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnetic switch.
9.
INSPECT BEARING
Turn the bearing by hand while applying inward force.
If resistance is felt or the bearing sticks, replace the bearing.
(See page ST–11)
B01164
Author:
Date:
1717
ST–11
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
ST03M–03
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
REPLACE CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
Disassemble the starter housing and the clutch assembly.
(1) Mount a brass bar in a vise, and install the starter
housing and clutch assembly to the brass bar.
B01224
(2)
(3)
Push down the pinion gear.
Using a plastic–faced hammer, tap down the stop
collar.
(4)
Using a screwdriver, pry out the snap ring.
(5)
Remove these parts:
Stop collar
Pinion gear
Compression spring
(6)
Push down the starter housing, and remove the
spring retainer.
Disassemble these parts:
Starter housing
Starter clutch
Compression spring
Clutch shaft
B01225
B01226
Stop Collar
Pinion Gear
Compression
Spring
B01227
(7)
B01228
Author:
Date:
1718
ST–12
STARTING (5S–FE)
Starter Housing
(b)
Compression
Spring
Starter
Clutch
Clutch
Shaft
–
STARTER
Assemble the starter housing and the clutch assembly
(1) Assemble these parts:
Starter housing
Starter clutch
Compression spring
Clutch shaft
B01229
(2)
Mount a brass bar in a vise, install the starter housing and clutch assembly to the brass bar.
(3)
Push down the starter housing, and install these
parts:
Spring retainer
Compression spring
Pinion gear
Stop collar
(4)
(5)
Push down the pinion gear.
Using snap ring pliers, install a new snap ring.
(6)
(7)
Using pliers, compress the snap ring.
Check that the snap ring fits correctly.
B01230
Stop
Collar
Pinion
Gear
Compression
Spring
B01231
Spring
Retainer
B01670
B01232
B01233
Author:
Date:
1719
ST–13
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
(8)
(9)
STARTER
Remove the starter housing and clutch assembly
from the brass bar.
Using a plastic–faced hammer, tap the clutch shaft
and install the stop collar onto the snap ring.
B01165
SST
2.
(a)
REPLACE FRONT BEARING
Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09286–46011
P10595
(b) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the bearing installation direction.
SST 09820–00030
Upward
SST
Downward
P10596
SST
3.
(a)
REPLACE REAR BEARING
Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09286–46011
(b)
Using a press, press in a new bearing.
P10593
P10594
Author:
Date:
1720
ST–14
STARTING (5S–FE)
4.
(a)
–
STARTER
REPLACE MAGNETIC SWITCH TERMINAL KIT
PARTS
Remove the 3 bolts, end cover, gasket and plunger.
B01234
(b)
Using vernier calipers, measure the contact plate for
depth of wear.
Maximum wear: 0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
If the depth of wear is greater than the maximum, replace the
contact plate.
B01235
(c)
Remove the terminal kit parts.
(1) Using SST, loosen the terminal nuts.
SST 09810–38140
(2) Terminal C:
Remove the terminal nut, wave washer, terminal insulator (outside), O–ring, terminal bolt, contact
plate and terminal insulator (inside).
(3) Terminal 30:
Remove the terminal nut, wave washer, terminal insulator (outside), packing, O–ring, terminal bolt,
contact plate, terminal insulator (inside).
(d)
Temporarily install these new terminal 30 kit parts:
(1) Terminal insulator (inside)
(2) Contact plate
(3) Terminal bolt
(4) O–ring
(5) Packing and terminal insulator (outside)
Install the packing to the terminal insulator, and
install them.
SST
B01236
Long
(1)
Short
Inside
(4) (5)
(3) (2)
(6)(7)
Identation
Protrusion
B06419
Author:
Date:
1721
ST–15
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
HINT:
Match the protrusion of the insulator with the indentation of the
housing.
(6) Wave washer
(7) Terminal nut
NOTICE:
Be careful to install the terminal insulators
(inside) and wave washers in the correct direction.
(e)
Long
Short
(7)(6) (5) (4)
(2) (3)
(1)
(7)
Inside
Lead Terminal
B01238
Wooden Block
40 mm
37 mm
20 mm
Contact Plate
B01239
Temporarily install these new terminal C kit parts:
(1) Terminal insulator (inside)
(2) Contact plate
(3) Terminal bolt
(4) O–ring
(5) Terminal insulator (outside)
(6) Wave washer
(7) Terminal nut
NOTICE:
Be careful to install the terminal insulators
(inside) and wave washers in the correct direction.
(f)
Temporarily tighten the terminal nuts.
(g)
Tighten terminal nuts.
(1) Put a wooden block on the contact plate and press
it down with a hand press.
Dimensions of wooden block:
20 x 37 x 40 mm (0.79 x 1.46 x 1.57 in.)
Press force:
981 N (100 kgf, 221 lbf)
NOTICE:
Check the diameter of the hand press ram. Then calculate the gauge pressure of the press when 981 N
(100 kgf, 221 lbf) of force is applied.
Gauge pressure:
100 kgf
Ram diameter (cm) 2
x 3.14 (π)
2
221 lbf
2
Ram diameter (in.)
x 3.14 (π)
2
(kgf/cm2) =
(psi) =
(kPa) = (kgf/cm2) x 98.1
(kPa) = (psi) x 6.9
Author:
Date:
1722
ST–16
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
If the contact plate is not pressed down with the specified pressure, the contact plate may tilt due to coil
deformation or the tightening of the nut.
(2) Using SST, tighten the nuts to the specified torque.
SST 09810–38140
Torque: 17 N·m (173 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
If the nut is over tightened, it may cause cracks on the inside of the insulator.
SST
B01240
(h)
(i)
Clean the contact surfaces of the remaining contact plate
and plunger with a dry shop rag.
Reinstall the plunger, a new gasket and the end cover
with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 2.5 N·m (26 kgf·cm, 23 in.·lbf)
B01241
Author:
Date:
1723
ST–17
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
ST03N–02
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly. (See page ST–6)
HINT:
Use high–temperature grease to lubricate the bearings, springs, steel ball and gears when assembling the
starter.
Author:
Date:
1724
ST–18
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
ST03O–01
TEST
Terminal C
Terminal 50
Battery
NOTICE:
These tests must be done within 3 to 5 seconds to avoid
burning out the coil.
1.
DO PULL–IN TEST
(a) Disconnect the field coil lead wire from terminal C.
(b) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as shown.
Check that the clutch pinion gear moves outward.
B01242
Disconnect
Terminal C
2.
DO HOLD–IN TEST
With battery connected as above with the clutch pinion gear
out, disconnect the negative (–) lead from terminal C. Check
that the pinion gear remains out.
Battery
B01243
3.
INSPECT CLUTCH PINION GEAR RETURN
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the switch body.
Check that the clutch pinion gear returns inward.
Disconnect
Battery
B01244
4.
(a)
(b)
Terminal 30
Battery
Terminal 50
DO NO–LOAD PERFORMANCE TEST
Connect the battery and ammeter to the starter as shown.
Check that the starter rotates smoothly and steadily with
the pinion gear moving out. Check that the ammeter
shows the specified current.
Specified current: 90 A or less at 11.5 V
Ammeter
B01245
Author:
Date:
1725
ST–19
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER
ST03P–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page ST–5)
Author:
Date:
1726
ST–20
STARTING (5S–FE)
–
STARTER RELAY
STARTER RELAY
ST03Q–01
INSPECTION
1.
2.
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
REMOVE STARTER RELAY (Marking: ST)
Starter
Relay
B00796
Ohmmeter
No
1
Continuity
Continuity
5
Ohmmeter
3
2
3.
(a)
INSPECT STARTER RELAY
Inspect the relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
3 and 5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
P07170
(b)
Inspect the relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
4.
REINSTALL STARTER RELAY
5.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
Ohmmeter
Continuity
1
5
3
2
Battery
P07171
Author:
Date:
1727
ST–1
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTING SYSTEM
STARTING SYSTEM
ST01T–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
Before changing the starter, check the following items again:
Connector connection
Accessory installation, e.g.: theft deterrent system
Author:
Date:
1728
ST–2
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
STARTER
ST01U–04
COMPONENTS
Hold Down Clamp
Battery
Battery Tray
Throttle Cable
Clamp (A/T)
Cruise Control
Cover
Cruise
Control
Actuator
Connector
Starter
Clamp
Starter Wire
Cruise Control Actuator
Starter Connector
B01274
Author:
Date:
1729
ST–3
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
Snap Ring
Starter Housing
Stop Collar
Pinion Gear
Compression Spring
Spring Retainer
Starter Clutch
Compression Spring
Starter Housing and
Clutch Assembly
Clutch Shaft
Idler Gear
Bearing
Steel Ball
Front Bearing
Return
Spring
Magnetic Switch
Assembly
Armature
Rear Bearing
O–Ring
Field Frame
(Field Coil)
O–Ring
Brush Holder
End Cover
Dust Protector
Non–reusable part
B01154
Author:
Date:
1730
ST–4
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
Magnetic Switch Assembly
Terminal Insulator
Terminal Nut
Contact Plate
17 (173, 13)
Terminal C Kit part
Terminal
Bolt
Wave Washer
Terminal Insulator
O–Ring
Gasket
Plunger
End Cover
Lead Terminal
O–Ring
Packing
Terminal Bolt
Terminal Insulator
Wave Washer
Terminal Nut
Terminal 30 Kit Part
17 (173, 13)
Contact Plate
Terminal Insulator
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06418
Author:
Date:
1731
ST–5
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
ST01V–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE BATTERY AND TRAY
w/ CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Disconnect the actuator connector and clamp.
Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the actuator with the bracket.
REMOVE STARTER
Disconnect the starter connector.
Remove the 2 bolts, throttle cable clamp (A/T) and starter.
Remove the nut, and disconnect the starter wire.
Torque: 37 N·m (380 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1732
ST–6
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
ST01W–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE DUST PROTECTOR
REMOVE FIELD FRAME AND ARMATURE
Remove the nut, and disconnect the lead wire from the
magnetic switch terminal.
Torque: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in.·lbf)
Remove the 2 through bolts.
Torque: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in.·lbf)
B01156
Identation
Protrusion
(c) Pull out the field frame together with the armature.
HINT:
Align the protrusion of the field frame with the groove of the
magnetic switch.
(d) Remove the O–ring from the field frame.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Use a new O–ring.
B01157
3.
(a)
REMOVE STARTER HOUSING, CLUTCH
ASSEMBLY AND GEAR
Remove the 2 screws.
Torque: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in.·lbf)
B01158
(b)
(1)
(4)
(3)
(2)
Remove these parts from the magnetic switch:
(1) Starter housing and clutch assembly
(2) Return spring
(3) Idler gear
(4) Bearing
B01160
4.
REMOVE STEEL BALL
Using a magnetic finger, remove the steel ball from the clutch
shaft hole.
B01159
Author:
Date:
1733
ST–7
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
5.
(a)
(b)
–
STARTER
REMOVE BRUSH HOLDER
Remove the 2 screws and end cover from the field frame.
Torque: 1.5 N·m (15 kgf·cm, 13 in.·lbf)
Remove the O–ring from the field frame.
B01161
(c)
Using a screwdriver, hold the spring back and disconnect
the brush from the brush holder. Disconnect the 4
brushes, and remove the brush holder.
NOTICE:
Check that the positive (+) lead wires are not grounded.
6.
REMOVE ARMATURE FROM FIELD FRAME
P13528
Author:
Date:
1734
ST–8
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
ST01X–03
INSPECTION
Ohmmeter
1.
(a)
INSPECT ARMATURE COIL
Check the commutator for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the segments of the commutator.
If there is no continuity between any segment, replace the armature.
Continuity
P10584
(b)
Check the commutator for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the commutator and armature coil core.
If there is continuity, replace the armature.
2.
INSPECT COMMUTATOR
(a) Check the commutator for the dirty and burnt surfaces.
If the surface is dirty or burnt, correct it with sandpaper (No.400)
or on a lathe.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P10585
(b)
Check for the commutator circle runout.
(1) Place the commutator on V–blocks.
(2) Using a dial gauge, measure the circle runout.
Maximum circle runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, correct it on a lathe.
P10586
(c)
Using vernier calipers, measure the commutator diameter.
Standard diameter: 30.0 mm (1.181 in.)
Minimum diameter: 29.0 mm (1.142 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the armature.
P10587
(d)
Check that the undercut depth is clean and free of foreign
materials. Smooth out the edge.
Standard undercut depth: 0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
Minimum undercut depth: 0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
If the undercut depth is less than minimum, correct it with a
hacksaw blade.
ST0040
Author:
Date:
1735
ST–9
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
3.
(a)
INSPECT FIELD COIL
Check the field coil for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the lead wire and field coil brush lead.
If there is no continuity, replace the field frame.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
P10588
(b)
Check the field coil for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the field coil end and field frame.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the field frame.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P10589
4.
INSPECT BRUSHES
Using vernier calipers, measure the brush length.
Standard length: 15.5 mm (0.610 in.)
Minimum length: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
If the length is less than minimum, replace the brush holder and
field frame.
Brush Holder Side
Length
Field Flame Side
Length
Z10079
5.
INSPECT BRUSH SPRINGS
Check the brush spring load.
Take the pull scale reading the instant the brush spring
separates from the brush.
Standard spring installed load:
1.2 kW
13.7 – 19.6 N (1.4 – 2.0 kgf, 3.0 – 4.4 lbf)
1.4 kW
17.6 – 23.5 N (1.8 – 2.4 kgf, 3.9 – 5.3 lbf)
Minimum spring installed load:
ST0019
1.2 kW
9.8 N (1.0 kgf, 2.2 lbf)
1.4 kW
11.8 N (1.2 kgf, 2.6 lbf)
If the installed load is less than minimum, replace the brush
springs.
Author:
Date:
1736
ST–10
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P13481
–
STARTER
6.
INSPECT BRUSH HOLDER
Check the brush holder insulation.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the positive (+) and negative (–) brush holders.
If there is continuity, repair or replace the brush holder.
7.
INSPECT CLUTCH AND GEAR
(a) Check the gear teeth on the pinion gear, idler gear and
clutch assembly for wear or damage.
If damaged, replace the gear or clutch assembly.
If damaged, also check the ring gear of the flywheel/drive plate
for wear or damage.
(b)
Check the clutch pinion gear.
Hold the starter clutch and rotate the pinion gear counterclockwise, and check that it turns freely. Try to rotate the
pinion gear clockwise and check that it locks.
If necessary, replace the clutch assembly.
Lock
Free
B01162
Terminal C
Ohmmeter
8.
(a)
INSPECT MAGNETIC SWITCH
Check the pull–in coil for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals 50 and C.
If there is no continuity, check and replace the magnetic switch.
Continuity
Terminal 50
B01163
(b)
Ohmmeter
Continuity
Terminal 50
Check the hold–in coil for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminal 50 and the switch body.
If there is no continuity, replace the magnetic switch.
9.
INSPECT BEARING
Turn the bearing by hand while applying inward force.
If resistance is felt or the bearing sticks, replace the bearing.
(See page ST–11)
B01164
Author:
Date:
1737
ST–11
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
ST01Y–03
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
REPLACE CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
Disassemble the starter housing and the clutch assembly.
(1) Mount a brass bar in a vise, and install the starter
housing and clutch assembly to the brass bar.
B01224
(2)
(3)
Push down the pinion gear.
Using a plastic–faced hammer, tap down the stop
collar.
(4)
Using a screwdriver, pry out the snap ring.
(5)
Remove these parts:
Stop collar
Pinion gear
Compression spring
(6)
Push down the starter housing, and remove the
spring retainer.
Disassemble these parts:
Starter housing
Starter clutch
Compression spring
Clutch shaft
B01225
B01226
Stop Collar
Pinion Gear
Compression
Spring
B01227
(7)
B01228
Author:
Date:
1738
ST–12
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
Starter Housing
(b)
Compression
Spring
Starter
Clutch
Clutch
Shaft
–
STARTER
Assemble the starter housing and the clutch assembly
(1) Assemble these parts:
Starter housing
Starter clutch
Compression spring
Clutch shaft
B01229
(2)
Mount a brass bar in a vise, install the starter housing and clutch assembly to the brass bar.
(3)
Push down the starter housing, and install these
parts:
Spring retainer
Compression spring
Pinion gear
Stop collar
(4)
(5)
Push down the pinion gear.
Using snap ring pliers, install a new snap ring.
(6)
(7)
Using pliers, compress the snap ring.
Check that the snap ring fits correctly.
B01230
Stop
Collar
Pinion
Gear
Compression
Spring
B01231
Spring
Retainer
B01670
B01232
B01233
Author:
Date:
1739
ST–13
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
(8)
(9)
STARTER
Remove the starter housing and clutch assembly
from the brass bar.
Using a plastic–faced hammer, tap the clutch shaft
and install the stop collar onto the snap ring.
B01165
SST
2.
(a)
REPLACE FRONT BEARING
Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09286–46011
P10595
(b) Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the bearing installation direction.
SST 09820–00030
Upward
SST
Downward
P10596
SST
3.
(a)
REPLACE REAR BEARING
Using SST, remove the bearing.
SST 09286–46011
(b)
Using a press, press in a new bearing.
P10593
P10594
Author:
Date:
1740
ST–14
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
4.
(a)
–
STARTER
REPLACE MAGNETIC SWITCH TERMINAL KIT
PARTS
Remove the 3 bolts, end cover, gasket and the plunger.
B01234
(b)
Using vernier calipers, measure the contact plate for
depth of wear.
Maximum wear: 0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
If the depth of wear is greater than the maximum, replace the
contact plate.
B01235
(c)
Remove the terminal kit parts.
(1) Using SST, loosen the terminal nuts.
SST 09810–38140
(2) Terminal C:
Remove the terminal nut, wave washer, terminal insulator (outside), O–ring, terminal bolt, contact
plate and terminal insulator (inside).
(3) Terminal 30:
Remove the terminal nut, wave washer, terminal insulator (outside), packing, O–ring, terminal bolt,
contact plate, terminal insulator (inside).
(d)
Temporarily install these new terminal 30 kit parts:
(1) Terminal insulator (inside)
(2) Contact plate
(3) Terminal bolt
(4) O–ring
(5) Packing and terminal insulator (outside)
Install the packing to the terminal insulator, and
install them.
SST
B01236
(1)
Long
Short
Inside
(4) (5)
(3) (2)
(6) (7)
Identation
Protrusion
B06419
Author:
Date:
1741
ST–15
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
HINT:
Match the protrusion of the insulator with the indentation of the
housing.
(6) Wave washer
(7) Terminal nut
NOTICE:
Be careful to install the terminal insulators
(inside) and wave washers in the correct direction.
(e)
Long
Short
(7)(6) (5) (4)
(2) (3)
(1)
(7)
Inside
Lead Terminal
B01238
Wooden Block
40 mm
37 mm
20 mm
Contact Plate
B01239
Temporarily install these new terminal C kit parts:
(1) Terminal insulator (inside)
(2) Contact plate
(3) Terminal bolt
(4) O–ring
(5) Terminal insulator (outside)
(6) Wave washer
(7) Terminal nut
NOTICE:
Be careful to install the terminal insulators
(inside) and wave washers in the correct direction.
(f)
Temporarily tighten the terminal nuts.
(g)
Tighten terminal nuts.
(1) Put a wooden block on the contact plate and press
it down with a hand press.
Dimensions of wooden block:
20 x 37 x 40 mm (0.79 x 1.46 x 1.57 in.)
Press force:
981 N (100 kgf, 221 lbf)
NOTICE:
Check the diameter of the hand press ram. Then calculate the gauge pressure of the press when 981 N
(100 kgf, 221 lbf) of force is applied.
Gauge pressure:
100 kgf
Ram diameter (cm) 2
x 3.14 (π)
2
221 lbf
2
Ram diameter (in.)
x 3.14 (π)
2
(kgf/cm2) =
(psi) =
(kPa) = (kgf/cm2) x 98.1
(kPa) = (psi) x 6.9
Author:
Date:
1742
ST–16
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
If the contact plate is not pressed down with the specified pressure, the contact plate may tilt due to coil
deformation or the tightening of the nut.
(2) Using SST, tighten the nuts to the specified torque.
SST 09810–38140
Torque: 17 N·m (173 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
If the nut is over tightened, it may cause cracks on the inside of the insulator.
SST
B01240
(h)
(i)
Clean the contact surfaces of the remaining contact plate
and plunger with a dry shop rag.
Reinstall the plunger, new gasket and end cover with the
3 bolts.
Torque: 2.5 N·m (26 kgf·cm, 23 in.·lbf)
B01241
Author:
Date:
1743
ST–17
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
ST01Z–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly. (See page ST–6)
HINT:
Use high–temperature grease to lubricate the bearings, springs, steel ball and gears when assembling the
starter.
Author:
Date:
1744
ST–18
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
ST020–01
TEST
Terminal C
Terminal 50
Battery
NOTICE:
These tests must be done within 3 to 5 seconds to avoid
burning out the coil.
1.
DO PULL–IN TEST
(a) Disconnect the field coil lead wire from terminal C.
(b) Connect the battery to the magnetic switch as shown.
Check that the clutch pinion gear moves outward.
B01242
Disconnect
Terminal C
2.
DO HOLD–IN TEST
With battery connected as above with the clutch pinion gear
out, disconnect the negative (–) lead from terminal C. Check
that the pinion gear remains out.
Battery
B01243
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CLUTCH PINION GEAR RETURN
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the switch body.
Check that the clutch pinion gear returns inward.
4.
(a)
(b)
DO NO–LOAD PERFORMANCE TEST
Connect the battery and ammeter to the starter as shown.
Check that the starter rotates smoothly and steadily with
the pinion gear moving out. Check that the ammeter
shows the specified current.
Specified current: 90 A or less at 11.5 V
Disconnect
Battery
B01244
Terminal 30
Battery
Terminal 50
Ammeter
B01245
Author:
Date:
1745
ST–19
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER
ST021–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page ST–5)
Author:
Date:
1746
ST–20
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
–
STARTER RELAY
STARTER RELAY
ST022–01
INSPECTION
1.
2.
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
REMOVE STARTER RELAY (Marking: ST)
Starter
Relay
B00796
Ohmmeter
No
1
Continuity
Continuity
5
Ohmmeter
3
2
3.
(a)
INSPECT STARTER RELAY
Inspect the relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
3 and 5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
P07170
(b)
Inspect the relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
4.
REINSTALL STARTER RELAY
5.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
Ohmmeter
Continuity
1
5
3
2
Battery
P07171
Author:
Date:
1747
SR–1
STEERING
–
STEERING SYSTEM
STEERING SYSTEM
SR06B–01
PRECAUTION
Care must be taken to replace parts properly because they could affect the performance of the
steering system and result in a driving hazard.
The CAMRY is equipped with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the driver airbag
and front passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service operation in the correct sequence could
cause the SRS to unexpectedly deployed during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement),
be sure to read the precautionary notices in the RS section.
Author:
Date:
2096
SR–2
STEERING
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
SR06C–01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in the order shown. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Hard steering
1. Tires (Improperly inflated)
2. Power steering fluid level (Low)
3. Drive belt (Loose)
4. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
5. Steering system joints (Worn)
6. Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
7. Steering column (Binding)
8. Power steering vane pump
9. Power steering gear
SA–2
SR–5
SR–3
SA–4
–
SA–45
–
SR–18
SR–31
Poor return
1. Tires (Improperly inflated)
2. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
3. Steering column (Binding)
4. Power steering gear
SA–2
SA–4
–
SR–31
Excessive play
1. Steering system joints (Worn)
2. Suspension arm ball joints (Worn)
3. Intermediate shaft, Sliding yoke (Worn)
4. Front wheel bearing (Worn)
5. Power steering gear
–
SA–45
–
SA–10
SR–31
Abnormal noise
1. Power steering fluid level (Low)
2. Steering system joints (Worn)
3. Power steering vane pump
4. Power steering gear
SR–5
–
SR–18
SR–31
Author:
Date:
2097
SR–3
STEERING
–
DRIVE BELT
DRIVE BELT
SR06D–01
INSPECTION
P06717
DENSO
Borroughs
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
(a) Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed cords
etc.
If any defect has been found, replace the drive belt.
HINT:
Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered acceptable. If the
belt has chunks missing from the ribs, it should be replaced.
(b)
Using a belt tension gauge, measure the belt tension.
Belt tension gauge:
DENSO BTG–20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No. BT–33–73F
5S–FE Engine:
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 95 – 145 lbf
Used belt: 60 – 100 lbf
1MZ–FE Engine:
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 150 – 185 lbf
Used belt: 95 – 135 lbf
Z00038
If the belt tension is not as specified, adjust it.
HINT:
CORRECT
WRONG
WRONG
P06723
”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used less than
5 minutes on a running engine.
”Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
After installing a belt, check that it fits properly in the
ribbed grooves.
Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has not
slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the pulley.
After installing a new belt, run the engine for about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
Author:
Date:
2098
SR–4
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING FLUID
POWER STEERING FLUID
SR06E–01
BLEEDING
1.
Normal
CHECK FLUID LEVEL
(See page SR–5)
2.
JACK UP FRONT OF VEHICLE AND SUPPORT IT
WITH STANDS
3.
TURN STEERING WHEEL
With the engine stopped, turn the wheel slowly from lock to lock
several times.
4.
LOWER VEHICLE
5.
START ENGINE
Run the engine at idle for a few minutes.
6.
TURN STEERING WHEEL
(a) With the engine idling, turn the wheel to left or right full
lock and keep it there for 2–3 seconds, then turn the
wheel to the opposite full lock and keep it there for 2–3 seconds.
(b) Repeat (a) several times.
7.
STOP ENGINE
8.
CHECK FOR FOAMING OR EMULSIFICATION
If the system has to be bled twice specifically because of foaming or emulsification, check for fluid leaks in the system.
9.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL
(See page SR–5)
Abnormal
R09599
Author:
Date:
2099
SR–5
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING FLUID
SR06F–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
R00427
HINT:
Check that the fluid level is within the HOT LEVEL range on the
reservoir. If the fluid is cold, check that it is within the COLD
LEVEL range.
(c) Start the engine and run it at idle.
(d) Turn the steering wheel from lock to lock several times to
boost fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature: 80°C (176°F)
(e)
Normal
CHECK FLUID LEVEL
Keep the vehicle level.
With the engine stopped, check the fluid level in the oil
reservoir.
If necessary, add fluid.
Fluid: ATF DEXRON® II or III
Abnormal
Check for foaming or emulsification.
If there is foaming or emulsification, bleed power steering
system.
(See page SR–4)
R09599
(f)
5 mm (0.2 in.)
or less
Engine Idling
Engine Stopped
R11562
With the engine idling, measure the fluid level in the oil
reservoir.
(g) Stop the engine.
(h) Wait a few minutes and remeasure the fluid level in the oil
reservoir.
Maximum fluid level rise: 5 mm (0.20 in.)
If a problem is found, bleed power steering system.
(See page SR–4)
(i)
Check the fluid level.
Author:
Date:
2100
SR–6
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING FLUID
2.
(a)
CHECK STEERING FLUID PRESSURE
Disconnect the pressure feed tube.
(See page SR–21)
(b) Connect SST, as shown below.
SST 09640–10010 (09641–01010, 09641–01030,
09641–01060)
NOTICE:
Check that the valve of the SST is in the open position.
5S–FE Engine :
1MZ–FE Engine :
Attachment
Attachment
SST
In
SST
Out
Attachment
In
Out
Pressure Feed Tube
Pressure Feed Tube
Attachment
W03331
(c)
(d)
(e)
Bleed the power steering system.
(See page SR–4)
Start the engine and run it at idle.
Turn the steering wheel from lock to lock several times to
boost fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature: 80 °C (176 °F)
Author:
Date:
2101
SR–7
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING FLUID
(f)
Oil
Reservoir
PS Gear
Closed
PS Vane
Pump
SST
With the engine idling, close the valve of the SST and observe the reading on the SST.
Minimum fluid pressure:
7,845 kPa (80 kgf·cm2, 1,138 psi)
NOTICE:
Do not keep the valve closed for more than 10 seconds.
Do not let the fluid temperature become too high.
Z15498
Oil
Reservoir
PS Gear
Open
PS Vane
Pump
SST
(g)
(h)
With the engine idling, open the valve fully.
Measure the fluid pressure at engine speeds of 1,000 rpm
and 3,000 rpm.
Difference fluid pressure:
490 kPa (5 kgf·cm2, 71 psi) or less
NOTICE:
Do not turn the steering wheel.
Z15499
(i)
Oil
Reservoir
Lock Position
PS Gear
PS Vane
Pump
SST
Z15500
With the engine idling and valve fully opened, turn the
steering wheel to full lock.
Minimum fluid pressure:
7,845 kPa (80 kgf·cm2, 1,138 psi)
NOTICE:
Do not maintain lock position for more than 10 seconds.
Do not let the fluid temperature become too high.
(j)
Disconnect the SST.
(k) Connect the pressure feed tube.
(See page SR–28)
(l)
Bleed the power steering system.
(See page SR–4)
Author:
Date:
2102
SR–8
STEERING
–
STEERING WHEEL
STEERING WHEEL
SR06G–01
INSPECTION
R07653
1.
CHECK STEERING WHEEL FREEPLAY
With the vehicle stopped and tires facing straight ahead, rock
the steering wheel gently back and forth with light finger pressure.
Freeplay should not exceed the maximum.
Maximum freeplay: 30 mm (1.18 in.)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
F01477
CHECK STEERING EFFORT
Center the steering wheel.
Remove the steering wheel pad.
(See page SR–11)
Start the engine and run it at idle.
Measure the steering effort in both directions.
Reference: 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in.·lbf)
HINT:
Be sure to consider the tire type, pressure and contact surface
before making your diagnosis.
(e) Torque the steering wheel set nut.
Torque: 35 N·m (360 kgf·cm, 26 ft·lbf)
(f)
Install the steering wheel pad.
(See page SR–16)
Author:
Date:
2103
SR–9
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
TILT STEERING COLUMN
SR06H–03
COMPONENTS
Steering Wheel Pad
35 (360, 26)
Torx Screw
7.1 (72, 63 in.·lbf)
Steering Wheel Lower
No.2 Cover
Steering Wheel
Torx Screw
7.1 (72, 63 in.·lbf)
Combination Switch
(w/ Spiral Cable)
Steering Wheel Lower
No.2 Cover
Column
Upper Cover
35 (360, 26)
Lower No.2
Cover
25 (260, 19)
35 (360, 26)
Steering Column Assembly
Column Lower Cover
Intermediate Shaft Assembly
Lower Instrument
Finish Panel
No.1 Lower Instrument Panel
Hood Lock Control Cable
Clip
LH Lower
Instrument Panel
Front Door Inside Scuff Plate
Cowl Side Trim
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
W03348
Author:
Date:
2104
SR–10
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
Key Cylinder Lamp Assembly
Key Unlock Warning Switch
Key Cylinder
w/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
Transponder Key
Amplifier
Ignition Switch
Column Upper Bracket
Transponder Key Coil
Turn Signal Bracket
A/T:
Key
Interlock
Solenoid
Energy Absorbing Plate
7 (70, 61 in.·lbf)
Energy Absorbing Clip
Column Upper Tube
Energy Absorbing Plate
Guide
19 (195, 14)
Tilt Lever
Return Spring
Column Tube
Tapered–Head Bolt
Energy Absorbing Plate
Column Tube Support
Energy Absorbing Plate
Guide
Lower Column Tube Attachment
Energy Absorbing Clip
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F01476
Author:
Date:
2105
SR–11
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
SR06I–03
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL PAD
NOTICE:
If the airbag connector is disconnected with the ignition switch at ON or ACC, DTCs will be recorded.
Never use airbag parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace with new ones.
Torx Screw
Screw Case
(a) Place the front wheels facing straight ahead.
(b) Remove the 2 steering wheel lower No.2 covers.
(c) Using a torx socket wrench, loosen the 2 torx screws.
HINT:
Loosen the 2 screws until the groove along the screw circumference catches on the screw case.
W03300
(d)
Pull the pad out from the steering wheel and disconnect
the airbag connector.
CAUTION:
When storing the wheel pad, keep the upper surface
of the pad facing upward.
Never disassemble the wheel pad.
NOTICE:
When removing the wheel pad, take care not to pull the airbag wire harness.
Airbag Connector
Correct
Wrong
W03301
Matchmarks
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
SST
(d)
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the steering wheel set nut.
Place matchmarks on the steering wheel and main shaft
assembly.
Using SST, remove the wheel.
SST 09950–50012 (09951–05010, 09952–05010,
09953–05020, 09954–05020)
W03302
Author:
Date:
2106
SR–12
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
3.
REMOVE UPPER AND LOWER COLUMN COVERS
(a) Remove the lower No.2 cover from the lower cover.
(b) Remove the 3 screws.
4.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE SCUFF PLATE
5.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM
Remove the clip.
6.
REMOVE No.1 LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Disconnect the hood lock control cable.
7.
REMOVE LH LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
Remove the 4 bolts.
8.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT FINISH PANEL
9.
REMOVE COMBINATION SWITCH WITH SPIRAL
CABLE
(a) Disconnect the 3 connectors.
(b) Disconnect the airbag connector.
(c) Remove the 3 screws.
10. REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE
(See page BE–23)
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the cable or apply oil to it.
11.
(a)
Matchmarks
W03303
DISCONNECT INTERMEDIATE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Place matchmarks on the intermediate shaft and control
valve shaft.
(b) Remove the bolt.
12. REMOVE INTERMEDIATE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Remove the bolt.
13. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 4 column assembly set nuts.
Author:
Date:
2107
SR–13
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
SR06J–01
DISASSEMBLY
Screw Extractor
W03333
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
1.
w/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
REMOVE TRANSPONDER KEY COIL WITH KEY CYLINDER LAMP ASSEMBLY
Remove the screw.
2.
w/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
REMOVE KEY CYLINDER LAMP ASSEMBLY
Remove the lamp assembly from the key coil.
3.
w/o ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
REMOVE KEY CYLINDER LAMP ASSEMBLY
Remove the screw.
4.
REMOVE COLUMN UPPER BRACKET AND COLUMN
UPPER CLAMP
(a) Using a centering punch, mark the center of the 2 tapered–head bolts.
(b) Using a 3–4 mm (0.12–0.16 in.) drill, drill into the 2 bolts.
(c) Using a screw extractor, remove the 2 bolts.
5.
REMOVE TURN SIGNAL BRACKET
Remove the 2 bolts.
6.
REMOVE TILT LEVER RETURN SPRING
7.
REMOVE COLUMN TUBE SUPPORT
(a) Remove the bolt and washer.
(b) Remove the tube support with lower column tube attachment.
(c) Remove the tube attachment from the tube support.
8.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE 2 ENERGY ABSORBING PLATES
Using pliers, remove the energy absorbing clip.
Remove the energy absorbing plate, energy absorbing
plate guide.
W03334
Author:
Date:
2108
SR–14
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
SR06K–01
INSPECTION
Ignition Key
1.
INSPECT STEERING LOCK OPERATION
Check that the steering lock mechanism operates properly.
W03335
2.
(a)
(b)
W03336
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE KEY CYLINDER
Place the ignition key at the ACC position.
Push down the stop pin with a screwdriver, and pull out
the cylinder.
Install a new cylinder.
(c)
HINT:
Make sure the key is at the ACC position.
3.
INSPECT IGNITION SWITCH
(See page BE–14)
4.
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE IGNITION SWITCH
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Install a new switch with the 2 screws.
5.
INSPECT KEY UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
(See page BE–14)
6.
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
(a) Slide out the switch.
(b) Install a new switch.
7.
A/T:
INSPECT KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
(A140E: See page AX–13)
(A541E: See page AX–17)
8.
A/T:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Install a new solenoid with the 2 screws.
9.
w/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
INSPECT TRANSPONDER KEY COIL
(See page BE–128)
10. w/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY
COIL
11. w/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Install a new key amplifier with the 2 screws.
Author:
Date:
2109
SR–15
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
SR06L–01
REASSEMBLY
W03347
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
1.
INSTALL 2 ENERGY ABSORBING PLATES
(a) Install the energy absorbing plate guide and absorbing
plate.
(b) Install the new energy absorbing clip.
2.
INSTALL COLUMN TUBE SUPPORT
(a) Install the tube attachment to the tube support.
(b) Torque the bolt and washer.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
3.
INSTALL TILT LEVER RETURN SPRING
4.
INSTALL TURN SIGNAL BRACKET
Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7 N·m (70 kgf·cm, 61 in.·lbf)
5.
W03337
INSTALL COLUMN UPPER BRACKET AND COLUMN
UPPER CLAMP
Tighten the 2 new tapered–head bolts until the bolt heads break
off.
6.
w/ ENGINE EMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
INSTALL KEY CYLINDER LAMP ASSEMBLY
Install the lamp assembly to the key coil.
7.
w/ ENGINE EMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
INSTALL TRANSPONDER KEY COIL WITH KEY CYLINDER LAMP ASSEMBLY
Tighten the screw.
8.
w/o ENGINE EMMOBILISER SYSTEM:
INSTALL KEY CYLINDER LAMP ASSEMBLY
Tighten the screw.
Author:
Date:
2110
SR–16
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
SR06M–01
INSTALLATION
Matchmarks
1.
(a)
W03303
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
Torque the 4 column assembly set nuts.
Torque: 25 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the connectors.
2.
INSTALL INTERMEDIATE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Torque the bolt.
Torque: 35 N·m (360 kgf·cm, 26 ft·lbf)
3.
CONNECT INTERMEDIATE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the intermediate shaft and control valve shaft.
(b) Torque the bolt.
Torque: 35 N·m (360 kgf·cm, 26 ft·lbf)
4.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE
(See page BE–23)
5.
INSTALL COMBINATION SWITCH WITH SPIRAL
CABLE
(a) Tighten the 3 screws.
(b) Connect the airbag connector.
(c) Connect the 3 connectors.
6.
INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT FINISH PANEL
7.
INSTALL LH LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
Tighten the 4 bolts.
8.
INSTALL No.1 LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
(a) Connect the hood lock control cable.
(b) Tighten the 2 screws.
9.
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM
Install the clip.
10. INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE SCUFF PLATE
11. INSTALL UPPER AND LOWER COLUMN COVERS
(a) Tighten the 3 screws.
(b) Install the lower No.2 cover to the lower cover.
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Mark
W02655
CENTER SPIRAL CABLE
Check that the front wheels are facing straight ahead.
Turn the cable counterclockwise by hand until it becomes
harder to turn the cable.
Then rotate the cable clockwise about 3 turns to align the
mark.
HINT:
The cable will rotate about 3 turns to either left or right of the
center.
Author:
Date:
2111
SR–17
STEERING
–
TILT STEERING COLUMN
13.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL
Align the matchmarks on the wheel and main shaft.
Torque the wheel set nut.
Torque: 35 N·m (360 kgf·cm, 26 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the connector.
14. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL PAD
NOTICE:
Make sure the wheel pad is installed to the specified
torque.
If the wheel pad has been dropped, or there are
cracks, dents or other defects in the case or connector, replace the wheel pad with a new one.
When installing the wheel pad, take care that the wirings do not interfere with other parts and are not
pinched between other parts.
Torx Screw
Screw Case
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
15.
Connect the airbag connector.
Install the pad after confirming that the circumference
groove of the torx screw is caught on the screw case.
Using a torx socket wrench, torque the 2 screws.
Torque: 7.1 N·m (72 kgf·cm, 63 in.·lbf)
Install the 2 steering wheel lower No.2 covers.
CHECK STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
W03304
Author:
Date:
2112
SR–18
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
SR06N–03
COMPONENTS
5S–FE Engine :
43 (440, 32)
*29 (293, 21)
Connector
Oil Pressure Switch
21 (210, 15)
Union Bolt
52 (525, 38)
Drive Belt
Clamp Plate
10 (100, 7)
Clamp Plate
Gasket
Holder
Return Hose
25 (250, 18)
*32 (326, 24)
Pressure Feed Tube
PS Vane Pump
Assembly
Clamp
43 (440, 32)
Front Fender
Apron Seal RH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
Non–reusable part
* For use with SST
W03364
Author:
Date:
2113
SR–19
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
1MZ–FE Engine :
43 (440, 32)
*29 (293, 21)
7.8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
Drive Belt
Connector
Oil Pressure Switch
21 (210, 15)
Union Bolt
52 (525, 38)
Clamp Plate
Gasket
Pressure Feed Tube
Return Hose
25 (250, 18)
*20 (203, 15)
Pressure Feed Tube
43 (440, 32)
PS Vane Pump Assembly
Holder
Clamp Plate
Clamp Plate
Front Fender Apron Seal RH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
Non–reusable part
* For use with SST
W03365
Author:
Date:
2114
SR–20
STEERING
Pressure Port Union
83 (850, 62)
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
5S–FE Engine :
TOYOTA KOUKI Made :
Rear Housing
24 (240, 17)
5S–FE Engine :
Rear Bracket
Oil Ring
Flow Control Valve
43 (440, 32)
Suction Port Union
Rear Housing
Spring
13 (130, 9)
O–Ring
Gasket
Front Housing
O–Ring
24 (240, 17)
5S–FE Engine :
Front Bracket
1MZ–FE Engine :
Rear Bracket
1MZ–FE Engine :
Front Bracket
43 (440, 32)
Straight Pin
Vane Pump Shaft
Vane Pump Pulley
Vane Pump
Rotor
x10
Wave Washer
Side Plate
Cam Ring
Vane Plate
O–Ring
Snap Ring
43 (440, 32)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Power steering fluid
W03349
Author:
Date:
2115
SR–21
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
SR06O–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
Remove the 2 bolts.
2.
DISCONNECT RETURN HOSE
NOTICE:
Take care not to spill fluid on the drive belt.
3.
(a)
5S–FE Engine :
SST
(b)
(c)
(d)
1MZ–FE Engine :
(e)
SST
(f)
(g)
Pressure
Feed Tube
DISCONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE
5S–FE Engine:
Remove the clamp plate set bolt and nut.
5S–FE Engine:
Remove the 2 clamp plates and 2 holders from the tube.
5S–FE Engine:
Remove the clamp from the tube.
1MZ–FE Engine:
Remove the 2 clamp plate set nuts.
1MZ–FE Engine:
Remove the bolt.
1MZ–FE Engine:
Remove the 2 clamp plates and 2 holders from the tube.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Using SST, disconnect the tube.
SST 09631–22020
W04220
Example 5S–FE Engine :
A
B
W03360
4.
REMOVE DRIVE BELT
Loosen the 2 (A and B) bolts.
5.
REMOVE PS VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH PRESSURE FEED TUBE
(a) Disconnect the connector from the oil pressure switch.
(b) Loosen bolt A sufficiently so that pump assembly can be
removed.
HINT:
Bolt A cannot be removed.
6.
REMOVE PRESSURE FEED TUBE
(a) Remove the oil pressure switch from the union bolt.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the switch.
If the switch is dropped or strongly damaged, replace it with a
new one.
(b) Remove the union bolt and gasket.
Author:
Date:
2116
SR–22
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
SR06P–01
DISASSEMBLY
Example 5S–FE Engine :
W03338
Example 5S–FE Engine :
SST
W03339
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
1.
MEASURE PS VANE PUMP ROTATING TORQUE
(a) Check that the pump rotates smoothly without abnormal
noise.
(b) Using a torque wrench, check the pump rotating torque.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Rotating torque:
0.3 N·m (2.8 kgf·cm, 2.4 in.·lbf) or less
2.
REMOVE VANE PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, to stop the pulley rotating, remove the nut.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–01000)
3.
REMOVE FRONT AND REAR BRACKETS
Remove the 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
4.
REMOVE SUCTION PORT UNION
(a) Remove the bolt.
(b) Remove the O–ring from the union.
5.
REMOVE PRESSURE PORT UNION, FLOW CONTROL
VALVE AND SPRING
Remove the O–ring from the union.
6.
REMOVE REAR HOUSING
(a) Remove the 4 bolts.
(b) Remove the 2 O–rings from the housing.
7.
REMOVE WAVE WASHER
8.
REMOVE SIDE PLATE
9.
REMOVE GASKET
10. REMOVE CAM RING, 10 VANE PLATES AND VANE
PUMP ROTOR
Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring from the vane pump
shaft.
NOTICE:
Take care not to drop the plate.
11. REMOVE VANE PUMP SHAFT
12. REMOVE STRAIGHT PINS
Remove the 2 pins from the front housing.
Author:
Date:
2117
SR–23
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
SR06Q–01
INSPECTION
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
1.
CHECK OIL CLEARANCE BETWEEN VANE PUMP
SHAFT AND BUSHING
Using a micrometer and caliper gauge, measure the oil clearance.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Standard clearance:
0.03 – 0.05 mm (0.0012 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum clearance: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If it is more than the maximum, replace the front housing and
vane pump shaft.
Caliper Gauge
Micrometer
Vane Pump Shaft
Bushing
Front Housing
R15196
2.
(a)
Thickness
Height
INSPECT VANE PUMP ROTOR AND VANE PLATES
Using a micrometer, measure the height, thickness and
length of the plates.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Minimum height: 8.6 mm (0.339 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.397 mm (0.0550 in.)
Minimum length: 14.991 mm (0.5902 In.)
Length
N00372
(b)
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the rotor groove and plate.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Maximum clearance: 0.035 mm (0.0014 in.)
If it is more than the maximum, replace the plate and/or rotor
with one having the same mark stamped on the cam ring.
Feeler Gauge
R10282
Author:
Date:
2118
SR–24
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Inscribed mark: 1, 2, 3, 4 or None
HINT:
There are 5 vane lengths with the following rotor and cam ring
marks:
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Inscribed Mark
Rotor and cam
ring mark
Vane plate part
number
Vane plate length
mm (in.)
None
44345–26010
14.999–15.001
(0.59051–0.59059)
1
44345–26020
14.997–14.999
(0.59043–0.59051)
2
44345–26030
14.995–14.997
(0.59035–0.59043)
3
44345–26040
14.993–14.995
(0.59027–0.59035)
4
44345–26050
14.991–14.993
(0.59020–0.59027)
R13897
3.
(a)
INSPECT FLOW CONTROL VALVE
Coat the valve with power steering fluid and check that it
falls smoothly into the valve hole by its own weight.
(b)
Check the valve for leakage. Close one of the holes and
apply 392–490 kPa (4–5 kgf/cm2, 57–71 psi) of compressed air into the opposite side, and confirm that air
does not come out from the end holes.
R11288
Compressed Air
R07591
If necessary, replace the valve with one having the same letter
as inscribed on the front housing.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Inscribed mark: A, B, C, D, E or F
Inscribed Mark
R11563
Author:
Date:
2119
SR–25
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
4.
INSPECT SPRING
Using a calipers, measure the free length of the spring.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Minimum free length: 32.3 mm (1.272 in.)
If it is not within the specification, replace the spring.
Calipers
R08702
5.
(a)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver with vinyl tape wound around its tip,
remove the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the front housing.
Vinyl Tape
R11290
(b)
(c)
Press
SST
Oil Seal
Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00330),
09950–70010 (09951–07100)
NOTICE:
Make sure to install the oil seal facing the correct direction.
W03541
Author:
Date:
2120
SR–26
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
SR06R–01
REASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
1.
COAT WITH POWER STEERING FLUID
(See page SR–18)
2.
INSTALL VANE PUMP SHAFT
3.
INSTALL STRAIGHT PINS
Using a plastic hammer, tap in 2 new pins.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the pins.
4.
INSTALL CAM RING
Align the holes of the ring and 2 straight pins, and install the ring
with the inscribed mark facing outward.
Inscribed Mark
5.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL VANE PUMP ROTOR
Install the rotor with the inscribed mark facing outward.
Install a new snap ring to the vane pump shaft.
R13458
6.
INSTALL VANE PLATES
Install the 10 plates with the round end facing outward.
7.
INSTALL GASKET
Install a new gasket.
8.
INSTALL SIDE PLATE
Align the holes of the plate and 2 straight pins.
Round End
R01149
R11292
9.
INSTALL WAVE WASHER
Install the washer so that its protrusions fit into the slots in the
side plate.
10. INSTALL REAR HOUSING
(a) Coat 2 new O–rings with power steering fluid and install
them to the housing.
(b) Torque the 4 bolts.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Torque: 24 N·m (240 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2121
SR–27
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
11.
INSTALL SPRING, FLOW CONTROL VALVE AND
PRESSURE PORT UNION
(a) Install the valve facing the correct direction.
(See page SR–18)
(b) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid and install it
to the union.
(c) Torque the union.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Torque: 83 N·m (850 kgf·cm, 62 ft·lbf)
12. INSTALL SUCTION PORT UNION
(a) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid and install it
to the union.
(b) Torque the bolt.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
13. INSTALL FRONT AND REAR BRACKETS
Torque the 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
14. INSTALL VANE PUMP PULLEY
Using SST to stop the pulley rotating, torque the nut.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–01000)
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
15. MEASURE PS VANE PUMP ROTATING TORQUE
(See page SR–22)
Example 5S–FE Engine :
SST
W03339
Author:
Date:
2122
SR–28
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
SR06S–01
INSTALLATION
5S–FE Engine :
Pressure Feed Tube
Stopper
1MZ–FE Engine :
Pressure
Feed
Tube
1.
INSTALL PRESSURE FEED TUBE
(a) Torque the union bolt with a new gasket.
HINT:
Make sure the stopper of the tube is touching the front bracket,
as shown, then torque the union bolt.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Torque: 52 N·m (525 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
(b) Install the oil pressure switch to the union bolt.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Torque: 21 N·m (210 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
Stopper
W03361
2.
INSTALL PS VANE PUMP ASSEMBLY WITH PRESSER FEED TUBE
Temporarily tighten the 2 (A and B) bolts.
3.
INSTALL DRIVE BELT
(a) Adjust drive belt tension.
(See page SR–3)
Example 5S–FE Engine :
A
B
W03360
(b)
5S–FE Engine :
SST
5S–FE Engine:
Using SST, torque the A bolt.
SST 09249–63010
Torque: 29 N·m (293 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300 mm (11.81
in.).
Fulcrum
Length
W03542
Author:
Date:
2123
SR–29
STEERING
(c)
1MZ–FE Engine :
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
1MZ–FE Engine:
Using SST, torque the A bolt.
SST 09249–63010
Torque: 29 N·m (293 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Clamp
Engine Wire
Fulcrum
Length
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300 mm
(11.81 in.).
Disconnect the clamp with engine wire.
(d) Torque the B bolt.
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(e) Connect the connector to the oil pressure switch.
NOTICE:
Be careful for oil on the connector.
SST
W03543
4.
(a)
5S–FE Engine :
SST
CONNECT PRESSURE FEED TUBE
Using SST, connect the tube.
SST 09631–22020
5S–FE Engine:
Torque: 32 N·m (326 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
1MZ–FE Engine:
Torque: 20 N·m (203 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Fulcrum
Length
1MZ–FE Engine :
Pressure
Feed Tube
(b)
SST
Fulcrum
Length
(c)
(d)
W04221
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
5.
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300 mm
(11.81 in.).
This torque value is effective in case that SST is parallel
to a torque wrench.
5S–FE Engine:
Install the clamp to the tube.
5S–FE Engine:
Install the 2 clamp plates and 2 holders to the tube.
5S–FE Engine:
Install the clamp plate set bolt.
5S–FE Engine:
Install the clamp plate set nut.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
1MZ–FE Engine:
Install the 2 clamp plates and 2 holders to the tube.
1MZ–FE Engine:
Tighten the bolt.
1MZ–FE Engine:
Install the 2 clamp plate set nuts.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
CONNECT RETURN HOSE
Author:
Date:
2124
SR–30
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING VANE PUMP
6.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL RH
Tighten the 2 bolts.
7.
BLEED POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(See page SR–4)
Author:
Date:
2125
SR–31
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
POWER STEERING GEAR
SR06T–01
COMPONENTS
19 (195, 14)
Stabilizer Bar
19 (195, 14)
No.1 Fuel Tube Protector
Clamp Plate
10 (100, 7)
Intermediate Shaft
Assembly
35 (360, 26)
25 (250, 18)
*32 (326, 24)
181 (1,850, 134)
Return
Tube
49 (500, 36)
Pressure Feed Tube
181 (1,850, 134)
PS Gear Assembly
49 (500, 36)
Cotter pin
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
Non–reusable part
* For use with SST
W03350
Author:
Date:
2126
SR–32
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
Rack Boot
Clip
Tie Rod End
Rack Housing
No.2 Grommet
Clamp
Rack Housing
No.2 Bracket
Lock Nut
74 (750, 54)
Rack Housing
Claw Washer
83 (850, 61)
*60 (615, 45)
Rack End
Steering Rack
O–Ring
Teflon Ring
Oil Seal
Cylinder End Stopper
Bushing
83 (850, 61)
*60 (615, 45)
Wire
Oil Seal
74 (750, 54)
O–Ring
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified touque
Non–reusable part
Molybdenum disulfide lithium base grease
Power steering fluid
* For use with SST
W04225
Author:
Date:
2127
SR–33
STEERING
13 (130, 9)
*10 (102, 7)
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
13 (130, 9)
*10 (102, 7)
18 (185, 13)
Turn Pressure Tube
O–Ring
Dust Seal
Turn Pressure Tube
13 (130, 9)
13 (130, 9)
*10 (102, 7)
*10 (102, 7)
Control Valve
Housing
O–RIng
18 (185, 13)
Oil Seal
Bearing
Control Valve Assembly
Teflon Ring
Rack Guide
Spring Cap
Lock Nut
Oil seal
Bearing
Gasket
Rack Guide
Seat
69 (700, 51)
*50 (513, 37)
Rack Guide
Spring Cap
Rack Guide Spring
Rack Housing
Rack Guide
Bearing
Self–Locking Nut
25 (250, 18)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Precoated part
Molybdenum desulfide lithium base grease
Power steering fluid
* For use with SST
Rack Housing Cap
59 (600, 43)
Z18921
Author:
Date:
2128
SR–34
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
SR06U–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL PAD
(See page SR–11)
3.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL
(See page SR–11)
4.
DISCONNECT RH AND LH TIE ROD ENDS
(See page SA–10)
5.
DISCONNECT INTERMEDIATE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page SR–11)
6.
DISCONNECT CLAMP PLATE
Remove the nut.
7.
SST
W04222
DISCONNECT PRESSURE FEED AND RETURN
TUBES
Using SST, disconnect the tube.
SST 09631–22020
8.
DISCONNECT STABILIZER BAR
Remove the 4 bolts.
HINT:
Do not remove the bar.
9.
REMOVE NO.1 FUEL TUBE PROTECTOR
Remove the 2 bolts and nut.
10. REMOVE PS GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 gear assembly set bolts and nuts.
HINT:
Lift up the stabilizer bar and remove the bolts.
(b) Remove the gear assembly from the LH of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the turn pressure tubes.
Author:
Date:
2129
SR–35
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
SR06V–01
DISASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
1.
SECURE PS GEAR ASSEMBLY IN VISE
Using SST, secure the gear assembly in a vise.
SST 09612–00012
SST
W04228
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE 2 TURN PRESSURE TUBES
Using SST, remove the tube.
SST 09633–00020
Remove the 2 O–rings from the tube.
SST
W04229
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE RH AND LH TIE ROD ENDS AND LOCK
NUTS
Place matchmarks on the tie rod end and rack end.
Loosen the lock nut.
Matchmarks
R00429
4.
REMOVE RH AND LH CLIPS, RACK BOOTS AND
CLAMPS
Using a screwdriver, loosen the clamp.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot.
Mark the RH and LH boots.
W04230
5.
REMOVE RH AND LH RACK ENDS AND CLAW WASHERS
(a) Using a screwdriver and hammer, stake back the washer.
NOTICE:
Avoid any impact to the steering rack.
Claw Washer
R11644
Author:
Date:
2130
SR–36
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
(b)
Using a spanner (24 mm) to hold the steering rack steady,
and using SST, remove the rack end.
SST 09922–10010
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922–10010 in the direction shown in the illustration.
Mark the RH and LH rack ends.
(c) Remove the washer from the rack end.
SST
R11645
Rack Guide
Spring Cap Lock Nut
SST
6.
REMOVE RACK GUIDE SPRING CAP LOCK NUT
Using SST, remove the nut.
SST 09922–10010
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922–10010 in the direction shown in the illustration.
R11646
7.
Rack Guide
Spring Cap
(a)
(b)
8.
REMOVE RACK GUIDE SPRING CAP, RACK GUIDE
SPRING, RACK GUIDE AND RACK GUIDE SEAT
Using SST, remove the cap.
SST 09631–10021
Remove the seat from the guide.
REMOVE RACK HOUSING CAP
SST
R11647
9.
REMOVE SELF–LOCKING NUT
Using SST to stop the control valve shaft rotating, remove the
nut.
SST 09616–00010
10. REMOVE DUST COVER
SST
R11648
11.
(a)
Matchmarks
(b)
(c)
REMOVE CONTROL VALVE HOUSING WITH CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Place matchmarks on the valve housing and rack housing.
Remove the 2 bolts.
Remove the gasket from the rack housing.
R11553
Author:
Date:
2131
SR–37
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
12.
(a)
Press
Vinyl Tape
Shop Rag
R11554
REMOVE CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
To prevent oil seal lip damage, wind vinyl tape on the serrated part of the valve shaft.
(b) Press out the valve assembly with the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Place a shop rag between the valve housing and the
blocks.
Be careful not to drop the valve assembly.
Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
13. REMOVE OIL SEAL
Remove the oil seal from the control valve assembly.
14.
Matchmarks
(a)
REMOVE RACK HOUSING NO.2 BRACKET AND
GROMMET
Place matchmarks on the bracket and rack housing.
(b)
(c)
Using a screwdriver, pry the clamp of the bracket.
Remove the grommet from the bracket.
15.
(a)
REMOVE CYLINDER END STOPPER
Using SST, turn the stopper clockwise until the wire end
is visible through the service hole.
SST 09631–10021
Using SST, turn the stopper counterclockwise, and remove the wire.
SST 09631–10021
R11649
R11650
Cylinder End
Stopper
Wire
(b)
SST
R11651
Author:
Date:
2132
SR–38
STEERING
16.
(a)
Brass Bar
Bushing
(b)
(c)
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
REMOVE STEERING RACK AND BUSHING
Using a brass bar and hammer, tap out the rack with the
bushing.
Remove the bushing from the rack.
Remove the O–ring from the bushing.
R11555
17. REMOVE OIL SEAL
Using SST, press out the oil seal.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00290),
09950–70010 (09951–07360)
SST
Oil Seal
F01791
Author:
Date:
2133
SR–39
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
SR06W–01
INSPECTION
Dial Indicator
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
1.
INSPECT STEERING RACK
(a) Using a dial indicator, check the rack for runout and for
teeth wear and damage.
Maximum runout: 0.03 mm (0.0118 in.)
(b) Check the back surface for wear and damage.
R10072
Press
2.
(a)
SST
Oil Seal
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OIL SEAL AND BEARING
Using SST, press out the oil seal and bearing from the
control valve housing.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00250),
09950–70010 (09951–07200)
Bearing
F01792
(b)
(c)
Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00180, 09951–00320,
09952–06010), 09950–70010 (09951–07200)
NOTICE:
Make sure to install the oil seal facing the correct direction.
Press
SST
Bearing
SST
W03560
(d)
Press
(e)
SST
Bearing
Coat a new bearing with molybdenum disulfide lithium
base grease.
Using SST, press in the bearing.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00340),
09950–70010 (09951–07200)
F01793
3.
(a)
Brass Bar
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE 2 BEARINGS
Using a brass bar and hammer, tap out the bearing from
the rack housing.
Bearing
F01794
Author:
Date:
2134
SR–40
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
(b)
Using SST, press out the bearing from the rack housing.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00260),
09950–70010 (09951–07200)
(c)
Coat a new bearing with molybdenum disulfide lithium
base grease.
Using SST, press in the bearing.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00310),
09950–70010 (09951–07200)
Press
SST
Bearing
F01795
SST
Press
(d)
Bearing
F01796
(e)
Press
SST
(f)
Coat a new bearing with molybdenum disulfide lithium
base grease.
Using SST, press in the bearing.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00320),
09950–70010 (09951–07200)
Bearing
F01797
4.
(a)
SST
SST
Bushing
Oil Seal
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE OIL SEAL
Using SST, remove the oil seal from the bushing.
SST 09527–20011, 09612–24014 (09613–22011)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the bushing.
F01798
(b)
(c)
Press
SST
Oil Seal
Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00240, 09951–00400,
09952–06010)
NOTICE:
Make sure to install the oil seal facing the correct direction.
SST
F01799
Author:
Date:
2135
SR–41
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
5.
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE TEFLON RING AND O–
RING
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the teflon ring and O–ring
from the steering rack.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the groove for the teflon ring.
(b) Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid and install it.
R10955
(c) Expand a new teflon ring with your fingers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to over–expand the ring.
R06172
(d)
(e)
Coat the ring with power steering fluid.
Install the ring to the steering rack, and settle it down with
your fingers.
N00401
6.
(a)
Teflon Ring
R11572
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE TEFLON RINGS
Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 rings from the control
valve assembly.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the grooves for the teflon ring.
(b) Expand 4 new teflon rings with your fingers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to over–expand the teflon ring.
(c) Coat the rings with power steering fluid.
(d) Install the rings to the control valve assembly, and settle
them down with your fingers.
Author:
Date:
2136
SR–42
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
(e)
Carefully slide the tapered end of SST over the rings until
the rings fit to the steering rack.
SST 09631–20081
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the rings.
SST
Teflon Ring
R11573
Author:
Date:
2137
SR–43
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
SR06X–01
REASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
When using a vise, do not overtighten it.
1.
COAT WITH POWER STEERING FLUID OR MOLYBDENUM DISULFIDE LITHIUM BASE GREASE
(See pages SR–31)
2.
INSTALL OIL SEAL
(a) Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
(b) Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00240, 09951–00430,
09952–06010), 09950–70010 (09951–07360)
NOTICE:
Make sure to install the oil seal facing the correct
direction.
Take care that the oil seal does not get reversed as
you install it.
Press
SST
SST
Oil Seal
W03561
3.
(a)
INSTALL STEERING RACK
Install SST to the rack.
SST 09631–33010
HINT:
If necessary, scrape the burrs off the rack teeth end and burnish.
(b) Coat the SST with power steering fluid.
(c) Install the rack into the rack housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
(d) Remove SST.
Rack Teeth End
SST
W02101
4.
(a)
Vinyl Tape
R11574
INSTALL BUSHING
Coat a new O–ring with power steering fluid and install it
to the bushing.
(b) To prevent oil seal lip damage, wind vinyl tape on the
steering rack end, and apply power steering fluid.
(c) Install the bushing.
NOTICE:
Make sure to install the bushing facing the correct
direction.
Be careful not to damage the oil seal lip.
Author:
Date:
2138
SR–44
STEERING
SST
5.
(a)
Wire
(b)
(c)
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
INSTALL CYLINDER END STOPPER
Align the installation hole for the wire of the stopper with
the slot of the rack housing.
Install a new wire into the stopper.
Using SST, turn the stopper clockwise 450 ± 50°.
SST 09631–10021
Cylinder End
Stopper
R11656
6.
(a)
AIR TIGHTNESS TEST
Install SST to the rack housing.
SST 09631–12071
(b) Apply 53 kPa (400 mmHg, 15.75 in.Hg) of vacuum for
about 30 seconds.
(c) Check that there is no change in the vacuum.
If there is change in the vacuum, check the installation of the oil
seals.
SST
R00662
7.
INSTALL RACK HOUSING NO.2 BRACKET AND
GROMMET
Install the grommet to the bracket.
(a)
HINT:
Align the projection of the grommet with the hole of the bracket.
(b) Align the matchmarks on the bracket and rack housing.
R11657
(c)
Place the bracket in a vise and tighten the vise to fasten
the clamp.
R11658
8.
(a)
INSTALL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
To prevent oil seal lip damage, wind vinyl tape on the serrated part of the valve shaft.
(b) Coat the teflon rings with power steering fluid.
(c) Install the valve assembly into the valve housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the teflon rings and oil seal.
Vinyl Tape
R11575
Author:
Date:
2139
SR–45
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
9.
(a)
(b)
Press
SST
Oil Seal
W03562
INSTALL OIL SEAL
Coat a new oil seal lip with power steering fluid.
Using SST, press in the oil seal.
SST 09612–22011
NOTICE:
Make sure to install the oil seal facing the correct direction.
10. INSTALL CONTROL VALVE HOUSING WITH CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Place a new gasket on the rack housing.
(b) Align the matchmarks on the valve housing and rack
housing.
(c) Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
11. INSTALL SELF–LOCKING NUT
Using SST to stop the control valve shaft rotating, torque a new
nut.
SST 09616–00010
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
12. INSTALL DUST COVER
SST
R11648
13.
(a)
Punch
(b)
R11659
(c)
14.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL RACK HOUSING CAP
Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the cap.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Torque the cap.
Torque: 59 N·m (600 kgf·cm, 43 ft·lbf)
Using a punch and hammer, stake the 2 parts of the cap.
INSTALL RACK GUIDE SEAT, RACK GUIDE, RACK
GUIDE SPRING AND RACK GUIDE SPRING CAP
Install the seat to the guide.
Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the cap.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Temporarily install the cap.
Author:
Date:
2140
SR–46
STEERING
15.
(a)
Rack Guide
Spring Cap
(b)
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
ADJUST TOTAL PRELOAD
To prevent the steering rack teeth from damaging the oil
seal lip, temporarily install the RH and LH rack ends.
Using SST, torque the rack guide spring cap.
SST 09631–10021
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
SST
W03098
(c)
Using SST, return the cap 12°.
SST 09631–10021
(d)
Using SST, turn the control valve shaft right and left 1 or
2 times.
SST 09616–00010
Using SST, loosen the cap until the rack guide spring is
not functioning.
SST 09631–10021
12°
W03099
SST
(e)
W03100
(f)
SST
SST
Rack Guide
Spring Cap
Using SST and a torque wrench, tighten the cap until the
preload is within specification.
SST 09616–00010, 09631–10021
Preload (turning):
0.8 – 1.4 N·m (8 – 14 kgf·cm, 6.9 – 12.2 in.·lbf)
W03101
Author:
Date:
2141
SR–47
STEERING
Rack Guide
Spring Cap
Lock Nut
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
16.
(a)
SST
Fulcrum
Length
SST
W03102
INSTALL RACK GUIDE SPRING CAP LOCK NUT
Apply sealant to 2 or 3 threads of the nut.
Sealant:
Part No.08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
(b) Using SST to hold the rack guide spring cap, and using
SST, torque the nut.
SST 09631–10021, 09922–10010
Torque: 50 N·m (513 kgf·cm, 37 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922–10010 in the direction shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 345 mm (13.58
in.).
(c) Recheck the total preload.
Preload (turning):
0.8 – 1.4 N·m (8 – 14 kgf·cm, 6.9 – 12.2 in.·lbf)
(d) Remove the RH and LH rack ends.
17.
(a)
INSTALL RH AND LH CLAW WASHERS AND RACK
ENDS
Install a new claw washer, and temporarily install the rack
end.
HINT:
Align the claws of the washer with the steering rack grooves.
Claw
R11667
(b)
Fulcrum Length
SST
R15545
Brass Bar
Using a spanner (24 mm) to hold the steering rack steady,
and using SST, torque the rack end.
SST 09922–10010
Torque: 60 N·m (615 kgf·cm, 45 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Use SST 09922–10010 in the direction shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 345 mm (13.58
in.).
(c) Using a brass bar and hammer, stake the washer.
NOTICE:
Avoid any impact to the rack.
R11668
Author:
Date:
2142
SR–48
STEERING
18.
(a)
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
INSTALL RH AND LH RACK BOOTS, CLAMPS AND
CLIPS
Ensure that the steering rack hole is not clogged with
grease.
HINT:
If the hole is clogged, the pressure inside the boot will change
after it is assembled and the steering wheel is turned.
R11669
2 mm
(0.79 in.)
or less
SST
W04223
Fulcrum
Length
(b) Install the boot.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage or twist the boot.
(c) Using SST, tighten the clamp as shown in the illustration.
SST 09521–24010
19. INSTALL RH AND LH TIE ROD ENDS AND LOCK NUTS
(a) Screw the lock nut and tie rod end onto the rack end until
the matchmarks are aligned.
(b) After adjusting toe–in, torque the nut.
(See page SA–4)
Torque: 74 N·m (750 kgf·cm, 54 ft·lbf)
20.
(a)
SST
(b)
INSTALL 2 TURN PRESSURE TUBES
Coat 2 new O–rings with power steering fluid and install
them to the tube.
Using SST, install the tube.
SST 09633–00020
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
HINT:
W04231
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 250 mm
(9.84 in.).
This torque value is effective in case that SST is parallel
to a torque wrench.
Author:
Date:
2143
SR–49
STEERING
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
SR06Y–01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL PS GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the gear assembly from the LH of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the turn pressure tubes.
(b) Torque the 2 gear assembly set bolts and nuts.
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Lift up the stabilizer bar and install the bolts.
2.
INSTALL NO.1 FUEL TUBE PROTECTOR
Install the 2 bolts and nut.
3.
CONNECT STABILIZER BAR
Torque the 4 bolts.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
SST
Fulcrum
Length
W04224
4.
CONNECT PRESSURE FEED AND RETURN TUBES
Using SST, connect the tube.
SST 09631–22020
Torque: 32 N·m (326 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 300 mm
(11.81 in.).
This torque value is effective in case that SST is parallel
to a torque wrench.
5.
CONNECT CLAMP PLATE
Torque the nut.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
6.
CONNECT INTERMEDIATE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(See page SR–16)
7.
CONNECT RH AND LH TIE ROD ENDS
(See page SA–10)
8.
POSITION FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT
AHEAD
HINT:
Do it with the front of the vehicle jacked up.
9.
CENTER SPIRAL CABLE
(See page SR–16)
10. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL
(a) Install the wheel at straight–ahead position.
(b) Temporarily tighten the wheel set nut.
(c) Connect the connector.
11. BLEED POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(See page SR–4)
12. CHECK STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
Author:
Date:
2144
SR–50
STEERING
13.
14.
15.
–
POWER STEERING GEAR
TORQUE STEERING WHEEL SET NUT
Torque: 35 N·m (360 kgf·cm, 26 ft·lbf)
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL PAD
(See page SR–16)
CHECK FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SA–4)
Author:
Date:
2145
IN–1
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
IN00U–22
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.
INDEX
An INDEX is provided on the first page of each section to guide you to the item to be repaired. To assist you
in finding your way through the manual, the Section Title and major heading are given at the top of every
page.
2.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
At the beginning of each section, a General Description is given that pertains to all repair operations contained in that section.
Read these precautions before starting any repair task.
3.
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING tables are included for each system to help you diagnose the problem and find the
cause. The fundamentals of how to proceed with troubleshooting are described on page IN–21.
Be sure to read this before performing troubleshooting.
4.
PREPARATION
Preparation lists the SST (Special Service Tools), recommended tools, equipment, lubricant and SSM (Special Service Materials) which should be prepared before beginning the operation and explains the purpose
of each one.
5.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
Most repair operations begin with an overview illustration. It identifies the components and shows how the
parts fit together.
Example:
Filler Cap
Float
Clevis Pin
Gasket
Reservoir Tank
Boot
Grommet
Slotted Spring Pin
Clip
12 (120, 9)
Clevis
15 (155, 11)
Snap Ring
Washer
Lock Nut
Push Rod
Piston
Cylinder
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
N17080
Author:
Date:
1
IN–2
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The procedures are presented in a step–by–step format:
The illustration shows what to do and where to do it.
The task heading tells what to do.
The detailed text tells how to perform the task and gives other information such as specifications
and warnings.
Example:
Task heading : what to do
21. CHECK PISTON STROKE OF OVERDRIVE BRAKE
(a) Place SST and a dial indicator onto the overdrive brake piston as shown in the illustration.
SST 09350–30020 (09350–06120)
Illustration:
what to do and where
Set part No.
Detailed text :
Component part No.
how to do task
(b) Measure the stroke applying and releasing the compressed
air (392 785 kPa, 4 8 kgf/cm 2 or 57 114 psi) as shown
in the illustration.
Piston stroke: 1.40
0.0669 in.)
1.70 mm (0.0551
Specification
This format provides the experienced technician with a FAST TRACK to the information needed. The upper
case task heading can be read at a glance when necessary, and the text below it provides detailed information. Important specifications and warnings always stand out in bold type.
6.
REFERENCES
References have been kept to a minimum. However, when they are required you are given the page to refer
to.
7.
SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications are presented in bold type throughout the text where needed. You never have to leave the
procedure to look up your specifications. They are also found in Service Specifications section, for quick
reference.
8.
CAUTIONS, NOTICES, HINTS:
CAUTIONS are presented in bold type, and indicate there is a possibility of injury to you or other
people.
NOTICES are also presented in bold type, and indicate the possibility of damage to the components
being repaired.
HINTS are separated from the text but do not appear in bold. They provide additional information to
help you perform the repair efficiently.
9.
SI UNIT
The UNITS given in this manual are primarily expressed according to the SI UNIT (International System of
Unit), and alternately expressed in the metric system and in the English System.
Example:
Torque: 30 N·m (310 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2
IN–3
INTRODUCTION
–
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
IN0CN–03
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION AND
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
1.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The vehicle identification number is stamped on the vehicle
identification number plate and the certification label, as shown
in the illustration.
A: Vehicle Identification Number Plate
B: Certification Label
A
B
B01453
2.
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
The engine serial number is stamped on the engine block, as
shown in the illustration.
5S–FE engine:
1MZ–FE engine:
B02122
Author:
Date:
3
IN–4
INTRODUCTION
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
IN0CO–04
GENERAL INFORMATION
FI1066
BASIC REPAIR HINT
(a) Use fender, seat and floor covers to keep the vehicle
clean and prevent damage.
(b) During disassembly, keep parts in the appropriate order
to facilitate reassembly.
(c) Installation and removal of battery terminal:
(1) Before performing electrical work, disconnect the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(2) If it is necessary to disconnect the battery for inspection or repair, first disconnect the negative (–)
terminal cable.
(3) When disconnecting the terminal cable, to prevent
damage to battery terminal, loosen the cable nut
and raise the cable straight up without twisting or
prying it.
(4) Clean the battery terminals and cable ends with a
clean shop rag. Do not scrape them with a file or other abrasive objects.
(5) Install the cable ends to the battery terminals after
loosening the nut, and tighten the nut after installation. Do not use a hammer to tap the cable ends
onto the terminals.
(6) Be sure the cover for the positive (+) terminal is
properly in place.
(d) Check hose and wiring connectors to make sure that they
are connected securely and correctly.
(e) Non–reusable parts
(1) Always replace cotter pins, gaskets, O–rings, oil
seals, etc. with new ones.
(2) Non–reusable parts are indicated in the component
illustrations by the ”” symbol.
(f)
Seal Lock Adhesive
Z11554
Precoated parts
Precoated parts are bolts, nuts, etc. that are coated with
a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(1) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
caused to move in any way, it must be recoated with
the specified adhesive.
(2) When reusing precoated parts, clean off the old
adhesive and dry with compressed air. Then apply
the specified seal lock adhesive to the bolt, nut or
threads.
Author:
Date:
4
IN–5
INTRODUCTION
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
(3)
(g)
(h)
(i)
Medium Current Fuse and High Current Fuse
Equal Amperage Rating
(j)
Precoated parts are indicated in the component illustrations by the ”” symbol.
When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to prevent
leaks.
Carefully observe all specifications for bolt tightening
torques. Always use a torque wrench.
Use of special service tools (SST) and special service materials (SSM) may be required, depending on the nature
of the repair. Be sure to use SST and SSM where specified and follow the proper work procedure. A list of SST
and SSM can be found in Preparation section in this
manual.
When replacing fuses, be sure the new fuse has the correct amperage rating. DO NOT exceed the rating or use
one with a lower rating.
BE1367
Illustration
Symbol
Part Name
Abbreviation
FUSE
FUSE
MEDIUM CURRENT FUSE
M–FUSE
HIGH CURRENT FUSE
H–FUSE
FUSIBLE LINK
FL
CIRCUIT BREAKER
CB
V00076
Author:
Date:
5
IN–6
INTRODUCTION
(k)
(l)
CORRECT
(3)
(4)
(5)
IN0253
(6)
WRONG
CORRECT
(7)
(8)
IN0252
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
Care must be taken when jacking up and supporting the
vehicle. Be sure to lift and support the vehicle at the proper locations (See page IN–8).
Cancel the parking brake on the level place and
shift the transmission in Neutral (or N position).
When jacking up the front wheels of the vehicle at
first place stoppers behind the rear wheels.
When jacking up the rear wheels of the vehicle at
first place stoppers before the front wheels.
When either the front or rear wheels only should be
jacked up, set rigid racks and place stoppers in front
and behind the other wheels on the ground.
After the vehicle is jacked up, be sure to support it
on rigid racks . It is extremely dangerous to do any
work on a vehicle raised on a jack alone, even for
a small job that can be finished quickly.
Observe the following precautions to avoid damage to the
following parts:
(1) Do not open the cover or case of the ECU unless
absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals are
touched, the IC may be destroyed by static electricity.)
(2)
WRONG
–
To disconnect vacuum hoses, pull off the end, not
the middle of the hose.
To pull apart electrical connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wires.
Be careful not to drop electrical components, such
as sensors or relays. If they are dropped on a hard
floor, they should be replaced and not reused.
When steam cleaning an engine, protect the electronic components, air filter and emission–related
components from water.
Never use an impact wrench to remove or install
temperature switches or temperature sensors.
When checking continuity at the wire connector, insert the tester probe carefully to prevent terminals
from bending.
When using a vacuum gauge, never force the hose
onto a connector that is too large. Use a step–down
adapter for adjustment. Once the hose has been
stretched, it may leak air.
Author:
Date:
6
IN–7
INTRODUCTION
(m)
Example
(n)
IN0002
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
Installation and removal of vacuum hose:
(1) When disconnecting vacuum hoses, use tags to
identify how they should be reconnected to.
(2) After completing a job, double check that the vacuum hoses are properly connected. A label under the
hood shows the proper layout.
Unless otherwise stated, all resistance is measured at an
ambient temperature of 20°C (68°F). Because the resistance may be outside specifications if measured at high
temperatures immediately after the vehicle has been running, measurement should be made when the engine has
cooled down.
Author:
Date:
7
IN–8
INTRODUCTION
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
IN0CP–03
VEHICLE LIFT AND SUPPORT LOCATIONS
Front
JACK POSITION
Front..................... Front crossmember
Rear..................... Rear axle beam
CAUTION : When jacking–up the rear and front, make
sure the car is not carrying any extra weight.
PANTOGRAPH JACK POSITION
SUPPORT POSITION
Safety stand and swing arm type lift ...........................................
N20619
Author:
Date:
8
IN–9
INTRODUCTION
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
PLATE TYPE LIFT
L
B
Attachment
A
C
HINT :
Left and right set position
Place the vehicle over the center of the lift.
Front and rear set position
Align the cushion gum ends of the plate
with the attachment lower ends (A, C).
Align the attachment upper end (B) with the
front jack supporting point (L).
Attachment dimensions
85 mm (3.35 in.)
70 mm (2.76 in.)
100 mm (3.94 in.)
200 mm (7.87 in.)
N20620
Author:
Date:
9
IN–10
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
IN0CQ–03
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
Negative Cable
BO4111
(b)
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH SRS AIRBAG AND
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
The 1999 CAMRY is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), such as the driver airbag, front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly and seat
belt pretensioner.
Failure to carry out service operations in the correct sequence could cause the supplemental restraint system to
unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to
a serious accident.
Further, if a mistake is made in servicing the supplemental
restraint system, it is possible the SRS may fail to operate
when required. Before servicing (including removal or
installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure
to read the following items carefully, then follow the correct procedure described in this manual.
GENERAL NOTICE
(1) Malfunction symptoms of the supplemental restraint system are difficult to confirm, so the diagnostic trouble codes become the most important
source of information when troubleshooting. When
troubleshooting the supplemental restraint system,
always inspect the diagnostic trouble codes before
disconnecting the battery (See page DI–626).
(2) Work must be started after 90 seconds from the
time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The supplemental restraint system is equipped
with a back–up power source so that if work is
started within 90 seconds of disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery, the SRS
may deploy.)
When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, memory of the clock and
audio systems will be cancelled. So before starting
work, make a record of the contents memorized by
the each memory system. Then when work is finished, reset the clock and audio systems as before.
To avoid erasing the memory of each memory system, never use a back–up power supply from another battery.
Author:
Date:
10
IN–11
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
(3)
Even in cases of a minor collision where the SRS
does not deploy, the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly and
seat belt pretensioner should be inspected (See
page RS–16, RS–29, and BO–127).
(4) Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
(5) Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor if shocks
are likely to be applied to the sensor during repairs.
(6) Never disassemble and repair the airbag sensor assembly, steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag
assembly, side airbag assembly or seat belt pretensioner.
(7) If the airbag sensor assembly, steering wheel pad,
front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly or seat belt pretensioner has been dropped,
or if there are cracks, dents or other defects in the
case, bracket or connector, replace them with new
ones.
(8) Do not directly expose the airbag sensor assembly,
steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly or seat belt pretensioner
to hot air or flames.
(9) Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V
minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical circuit.
(10) Information labels are attached to the periphery of
the SRS components. Follow the instructions on the
notices.
(11) After work on the supplemental restraint system is
completed, check the SRS warning light (See page
DI–626).
(c)
SPIRAL CABLE (in Combination Switch)
The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the steering
column with the spiral cable at the neutral position, otherwise cable disconnection and other troubles may result.
Refer to SR–16 of this manual concerning correct steering wheel installation.
Marks
W02655
Author:
Date:
11
IN–12
INTRODUCTION
(d)
Example:
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
STEERING WHEEL PAD (with Airbag)
(1) When removing the steering wheel pad or handling
a new steering wheel pad, it should be placed with
the pad top surface facing up.
In this case, the twin–lock type connector lock lever
should be in the locked state and care should be
taken to place it so the connector will not be damaged. In addition do not store a steering wheel pad
on top of another one. Storing the pad with its metallic surface up may lead to a serious accident if the
airbag inflates for some reason.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
(3) Grease should not be applied to the steering wheel
pad and the pad should not be cleaned with detergents of any kind.
(4) Store the steering wheel pad where the ambient
temperature remains below 93°C (200°F), without
high humidity and away from electrical noise.
(5) When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) under the
steering column near the combination switch connector before starting work.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the steering wheel
pad alone, the airbag should be deployed using an
SST before disposal (See page RS–18).
Carry out the operation in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
Correct
Wrong
Z13953
Example:
Z13950
Author:
Date:
12
IN–13
INTRODUCTION
(e)
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Always store a removed or new front passenger airbag assembly with the airbag deployment direction
facing up.
Storing the airbag assembly with the airbag deployment direction facing down could cause a serious
accident if the airbag inflates.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
(3) Grease should not be applied to the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag door should not
be cleaned with detergents of any kind.
(4) Store the airbag assembly where the ambient temperature remains below 93°C (200°F), without high
humidity and away from electrical noise.
(5) When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) installed on
the assembly before starting work.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the airbag assembly
alone, the airbag should be deployed using an SST
before disposal (See page RS–31).
Perform the operation in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
Example:
Correct
Wrong
B00696
Example:
Z13951
Author:
Date:
13
IN–14
INTRODUCTION
(f)
Example:
Correct
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Always store a removed or new side airbag assembly with the airbag deployment direction facing up.
Storing the airbag assembly with the airbag deployment direction facing down could cause a serious
accident if the airbag deploys.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
(3) Grease should not be applied to the side airbag assembly and the surface should not be cleaned with
detergents of any kind.
(4) Store the airbag assembly where the ambient temperature remains below 93°C (200°F), without high
humidity and away from electrical noise.
(5) When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) under the
seat before starting work.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the side airbag assembly alone, the airbag should be deployed using
an SST before disposal (See page RS–42, RS–55).
Perform the operation in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
Wrong
B02129
Example:
N21642
Author:
Date:
14
IN–15
INTRODUCTION
(g)
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
(1) Never measure the resistance of the seat belt pretensioner. (This may cause the seat belt pretensioner to activate, which is very dangerous.)
(2) Never disassemble the seat belt pretensioner.
(3) Never install the seat belt pretensioner in another
vehicle.
(4) Store the seat belt pretensioner where the ambient
temperature remains below 80°C (176°F) and
away from electrical noise without high humidity.
(5) When using electric welding, first disconnect the
connector (yellow color and 2 pins) before starting
work.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the seat belt pretensioner alone, the seat belt pretensioner should be
activated before disposal (See page BO–128). Perform the operation in a safe place away from electrical noise.
(7) The seat belt pretensioner is hot after activation, so
let it cool down sufficiently before the disposal.
However never apply water to the seat belt pretensioner.
Example:
B02121
Author:
Date:
15
IN–16
INTRODUCTION
(h)
(i)
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(1) Never reuse the airbag sensor assembly involved
in a collision when the SRS has deployed.
(2) The connectors to the airbag sensor assembly
should be connected or disconnected with the sensor mounted on the floor. If the connectors are connected or disconnected while the airbag sensor assembly is not mounted to the floor, it could cause
undesired ignition of the supplemental restraint system.
(3) Work must be started after 90 seconds from the
time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, even if only loosing the set
bolts of the airbag sensor assembly.
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
The SRS wire harness is integrated with the instrument
panel wire harness assembly. All the connectors in the
system are a standard yellow color. If the SRS wire harness becomes disconnected or the connector becomes
broken due to an accident, etc., repair or replace it as
shown on page RS–73.
Author:
Date:
16
IN–17
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
2.
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A CATALYTIC CONVERTER
CAUTION:
If large amount of unburned gasoline flows into the converter, it may overheat and create a fire hazard. To prevent this, observe the following precautions and explain them to your customer.
(a) Use only unleaded gasoline.
(b) Avoid prolonged idling.
Avoid running the engine at idle speed for more than 20 minutes.
(c) Avoid spark jump test.
(1) Perform spark jump test only when absolutely necessary. Perform this test as rapidly as possible.
(2) While testing, never race the engine.
(d) Avoid prolonged engine compression measurement.
Engine compression tests must be done as rapidly as possible.
(e) Do not run engine when fuel tank is nearly empty.
This may cause the engine to misfire and create an extra load on the converter.
(f)
Avoid coasting with ignition turned off.
(g) Do not dispose of used catalyst along with parts contaminated with gasoline or oil.
3.
IF VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
For vehicles with mobile communication systems such as two–way radios and cellular telephones, observe
the following precautions.
(1) Install the antenna as far as possible away from the ECU and sensors of the vehicle’s electronic
system.
(2) Install the antenna feeder at least 20 cm (7.87 in.) away from the ECU and sensors of the vehicle’s electronic systems. For details about ECU and sensors locations, refer to the section on
the applicable component.
(3) Avoid winding the antenna feeder together with other wiring as much as possible, and also avoid
running the antenna feeder parallel with other wire harnesses.
(4) Check that the antenna and feeder are correctly adjusted.
(5) Do not install powerful mobile communications system.
Author:
Date:
17
IN–18
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
4.
FOR USING OBD II SCAN TOOL OR TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
CAUTION:
Observe the following items for safety reasons:
Before using the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held tester, the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book or TOYOTA hand–held tester’s operator manual should be read thoroughly.
Be sure to route all cables securely when driving with the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–
held tester connected to the vehicle. (i.e. Keep cables away from feet, pedals, steering wheel
and shift lever.)
Two persons are required when test driving with the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand–held
tester, one person to drive the vehicle and the other person to operate the OBD II scan tool or
TOYOTA hand–held tester.
5.
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH TRACTION CONTROL (TRAC) SYSTEM
NOTICE:
When using a 2–wheel drum tester such as a speedometer
tester or chassis dynamometer, etc., or jacking up the front
wheels and driving the wheels, always push in the TRAC
cut (”TRAC OFF”) switch and turn the TRAC system OFF.
TRAC OFF
Indicator Light
TRAC Cut
Switch
N21624
Confirm TRAC system is OFF
(1) Press the TRAC cut (”TRAC OFF”) switch.
(2) Check that the TRAC OFF indicator light comes on
when the TRAC system is turned OFF by the TRAC
cut switch.
HINT:
TRAC cut switch is reset after the ignition switch has been
turned OFF and ON.
The TRAC system can be operated.
(3)
Begin measurements.
N21622
Author:
Date:
18
IN–19
INTRODUCTION
–
(4)
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
Press the TRAC cut switch to turn the TRAC to the
operative mode and check that the TRAC OFF indicator light goes off.
HINT:
The SLIP indicator light blinks when the TRAC system in operation.
N21623
Author:
Date:
19
IN–20
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN05Y–07
GENERAL INFORMATION
A large number of ECU controlled systems are used in the 1999 CAMRY. In general, the ECU controlled
system is considered to be a very intricate system requiring a high level of technical knowledge and expert
skill to troubleshoot. However, the fact is that if you proceed to inspect the circuits one by one, troubleshooting of these systems is not complex. If you have adequate understanding of the system and a basic knowledge of electricity, accurate diagnosis and necessary repair can be performed to locate and fix the problem.
This manual is designed through emphasis of the above standpoint to help service technicians perform accurate and effective troubleshooting, and is compiled for the following major ECU controlled systems:
The troubleshooting procedure and how to make use of it are described on the following pages.
1. 5S–FE Engine
DI–1
2. 1MZ–FE Engine
DI–195
3. A140E Automatic Transaxle
DI–387
4. A541E Automatic Transaxle
DI–436
5. Anti–Lock Brake System (DENSO made)
DI–491
6. Anti–Lock Brake System (BOSCH made)
DI–537
7. ABS & Traction Control System
DI–572
8. Supplemental Restraint System
DI–624
9. Wireless Door Lock Control System
DI–800
10.Theft Deterrent System
DI–826
11.Cruise Control System
DI–868
12.Engine Immobiliser System
DI–919
FOR USING OBD II SCAN TOOL OR TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER
Before using the scan tool or tester, the scan tool’s instruction book or tester’s operator manual should
be read thoroughly.
If the scan tool or tester cannot communicate with ECU controlled systems when you have connected
the cable of the scan tool or tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON and operated the scan tool,
there is a problem on the vehicle side or tool side.
(1) If communication is normal when the tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect the diagnosis
data link line (Busline) or ECU power circuit of the vehicle.
(2) If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tool itself, so perform the Self Test procedures outline in the Tester Operator’s
Manual.
Author:
Date:
20
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–21
IN05W–08
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Carry out troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following page. Here, only the basic procedure is shown. Details are provided in Diagnostics section, showing the most effective methods for each
circuit. Confirm the troubleshooting procedures first for the relevant circuit before beginning troubleshooting
of that circuit.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
2
1
Ask the customer about the conditions and the
environment when the problem occurred.
Customer Problem
Analysis
Symptom Confirmation
and Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
3
Symptom Simulation
2, 3
Confirm the symptoms and the problem conditions,
and check the diagnostic trouble codes.
(When the problem symptoms do not appear
during confirmation, use the symptom simulation
method described later on.)
4
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Chart
5
6
Problem Symptoms Table
Circuit Inspection or Parts
Inspection
7
Repair
8
Confirmation Test
End
4, 5, 6
Check the results obtained in Step 2, then confirm
the inspection procedure for the system or the part
which should be checked using the diagnostic
trouble code chart or the problem symptoms table.
7
Check and repair the affected system or part in
accordance with the instructions in Step 6.
8
After completing repairs, confirm that the problem
has been eliminated.
(If the problem is not reproduced, perform the
confirmation test under the same conditions and
in the same environment as when it occurred for
the first time.)
Author:
Date:
21
IN–22
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
1.
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
In troubleshooting, the problem symptoms must be confirmed accurately and all preconceptions must be
cleared away in order to give an accurate judgment. To ascertain just what the problem symptoms are, it is
extremely important to ask the customer about the problem and the conditions at the time it occurred.
Important Point in the Problem Analysis:
The following 5 items are important points in the problem analysis. Past problems which are thought to be
unrelated and the repair history, etc. may also help in some cases, so as much information as possible should
be gathered and its relationship with the problem symptoms should be correctly ascertained for reference
in troubleshooting. A customer problem analysis table is provided in Diagnostics section for each system
for your use.
Important Points in the Customer Problem Analysis
What ––––– Vehicle model, system name
When ––––– Date, time, occurrence frequency
Where ––––– Road conditions
Under what conditions? ––––– Running conditions, driving conditions, weather conditions
How did it happen? ––––– Problem symptoms
(Sample) Engine control system check sheet.
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
Model and Model
Year
Driver’s Name
Frame No.
Data Vehicle
Brought in
Engine Model
License No.
Odometer Reading
Problem Symptoms
Customer’s Name
Engine does
not Start
Engine does not crank
Difficult to
Start
Engine cranks slowly
Other
Poor Idling
Incorrect first idle
Idling rpm is abnormal
Rough idling
Other
Poor
Drive ability
Hesitation
Knocking
Engine Stall
Soon after starting
After accelerator pedal depressed
After accelerator pedal released
During A/C operation
Shifting from N to D
Other
No initial combustion
Back fire
Other
High (
Muffler explosion (after–fire)
km
miles
No complete combustion
rpm)
Low (
rpm)
Surging
Others
Data Problem
Constant
Sometimes (
times per
day/month)
Author:
Date:
22
INTRODUCTION
–
IN–23
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
2.
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
The diagnostic system in the 1999 CAMRY fulfills various functions. The first function is the Diagnostic
Trouble Code Check in which a malfunction in the signal circuits to the ECU is stored in code in the ECU
memory at the time of occurrence, to be output by the technician during troubleshooting. Another function
is the Input Signal Check which checks if the signals from various switches are sent to the ECU correctly.
By using these check functions, the problem areas can be narrowed down quickly and troubleshooting can
be performed effectively. Diagnostic functions are incorporated in the following systems in the CAMRY.
System
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
Input Signal Check
(Sensor Check)
(with Check
Mode)
(with Check
Mode)
(with Check
Mode)
(with Check
Mode)
Engine (5S–FE)
Engine (1MZ–FE)
Automatic Transaxle (A140E)
Automatic Transaxle (A541E)
Anti–Lock Brake System (DENSO made)
Anti–Lock Brake System (BOSCH made)
ABS & Traction Control System
Supplemental Restraint System
Wireless Door Lock Control System
Theft Deterrent System
Cruise Control System
Engine Immobiliser System
Diagnostic Test
Mode (Active Test)
In diagnostic trouble code check, it is very important to determine whether the problem indicated by the diagnostic trouble code is still occurring or occurred in the past but returned to normal at present. In addition,
it must be checked in the problem symptom check whether the malfunction indicated by the diagnostic
trouble code is directly related to the problem symptom or not. For this reason, the diagnostic trouble codes
should be checked before and after the symptom confirmation to determine the current conditions, as shown
in the table below. If this is not done, it may, depending on the case, result in unnecessary troubleshooting
for normally operating systems, thus making it more difficult to locate the problem, or in repairs not pertinent
to the problem. Therefore, always follow the procedure in correct order and perform the diagnostic trouble
code check.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK PROCEDURE
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check (Make a
note of and then clear)
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Display
Confirmation
of Symptoms
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
Problem symptoms Same diagnostic
trouble code is
exist
displayed
Normal code is
displayed
Normal Code Display
Problem Condition
Problem is still occurring in the diagnostic
circuit
The problem is still occurring in a place
other than in the diagnostic circuit
(The diagnostic trouble code displayed
first is either for a past problem or it is a
secondary problem)
No problem
symptoms exist
The problem occurred in the diagnostic
circuit in the past
Problem symptoms Normal code is
exist
displayed
The problem is still occurring in a place
other than in the diagnostic circuit
No problem
symptoms exist
The problem occurred in a place other
than in the diagnostic circuit in the past
Normal code is
displayed
Author:
Date:
23
IN–24
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
Taking into account the points on the previous page, a flow chart showing how to proceed with troubleshooting using the diagnostic trouble code check is shown below. This flow chart shows how to utilize the diagnostic trouble code check effectively, then by carefully checking the results, indicates how to proceed either to
diagnostic trouble code troubleshooting or to troubleshooting of problem symptoms table.
Diagnostic trouble code check
Making a note of and clearing of the diagnostic trouble codes displayed
Symptom confirmation
Problem symptoms
exist
No problem symptoms
exist
Simulation test using the symptom
simulation methods
Diagnostic trouble code check
Diagnostic trouble code displayed
Problem symptoms exist
Normal code displayed
Problem symptoms exist
Troubleshooting of problem indicated
by diagnostic trouble code
Troubleshooting of each
problem symptom
Author:
Normal code displayed
No problem symptoms exist
System Normal
If a diagnostic trouble code was
displayed in the initial diagnostic
trouble code check, it indicates
that the trouble may have occurred
in a wire harness or connector in
that circuit in the past. Therefore,
check the wire harness and connectors (See page IN–31).
Date:
24
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–25
3.
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when there are no problem symptoms occurring. In such cases,
a thorough customer problem analysis must be carried out, then simulate the same or similar conditions and
environment in which the problem occurred in the customer’s vehicle. No matter how much experience a
technician has, or how skilled he may be, if he proceeds to troubleshoot without confirming the problem
symptoms he will tend to overlook something important in the repair operation and make a wrong guess
somewhere, which will only lead to a standstill. For example, for a problem which only occurs when the engine is cold, or for a problem which occurs due to vibration caused by the road during driving, etc., the problem can never be determined so long as the symptoms are confirmed with the engine hot condition or the
vehicle at a standstill. Since vibration, heat or water penetration (moisture) is likely cause for problem which
is difficult to reproduce, the symptom simulation tests introduced here are effective measures in that the external causes are applied to the vehicle in a stopped condition.
Important Points in the Symptom Simulation Test:
In the symptom simulation test, the problem symptoms should of course be confirmed, but the problem area
or parts must also be found out. To do this, narrow down the possible problem circuits according to the symptoms before starting this test and connect a tester beforehand. After that, carry out the symptom simulation
test, judging whether the circuit being tested is defective or normal and also confirming the problem symptoms at the same time. Refer to the problem symptoms table for each system to narrow down the possible
causes of the symptom.
1
VIBRATION METHOD: When vibration seems to be the major cause.
CONNECTORS
Slightly shake the connector vertically and horizontally.
Shake Slightly
WIRE HARNESS
Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and horizontally.
The connector joint, fulcrum of the vibration, and body
through portion are the major areas to be checked thoroughly.
Swing Slightly
PARTS AND SENSOR
Vibrate Slightly
Apply slight vibration with a finger to the part of the sensor
considered to be the problem cause and check that the malfunction occurs.
HINT:
Applying strong vibration to relays may result in open relays.
V07268
Author:
Date:
25
IN–26
2
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
HEAT METHOD: When the problem seems to occur when the suspect area is heated.
Heat the component that is the likely cause of the malfunction
with a hair dryer or similar object. Check to see if the malfunction
occurs.
M a l f u n ction
NOTICE:
(1) Do not heat to more than 60 °C (140 °F). (Temperature
is limited not to damage the components.)
(2) Do not apply heat directly to parts in the ECU.
3
WATER SPRINKLING METHOD: When the malfunction seems to occur on a rainy day or in a
high–humidity condition.
Sprinkle water onto the vehicle and check to see if the malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
(1) Never sprinkle water directly into the engine compartment, but indirectly change the temperature and humidity by applying water spray onto the radiator front
surface.
(2) Never apply water directly onto the electronic components.
HINT:
If a vehicle is subject to water leakage, the leaked water may
contaminate the ECU. When testing a vehicle with a water leakage problem, special caution must be taken.
4
OTHER: When a malfunction seems to occur when electrical load is excessive.
Turn on all electrical loads including the heater blower, head
lights, rear window defogger, etc. and check to see if the malfunction occurs.
ON
B02389
B02390
Author:
Date:
26
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–27
4.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
The inspection procedure is shown in the table below. This table permits efficient and accurate troubleshooting using the diagnostic trouble codes displayed in the diagnostic trouble code check. Proceed with troubleshooting in accordance with the inspection procedure given in the diagnostic chart corresponding to the
diagnostic trouble codes displayed. The engine diagnostic trouble code chart is shown below as an example.
DTC No.
Indicates the diagnostic trouble code.
Page or Instructions
Indicates the page where the inspection procedure
for each circuit is to be found, or gives instructions
for checking and repairs.
Trouble Area
Indicates the suspect area of the
problem.
Detection Item
Indicates the system of the problem or
contents of the problem.
DTC CHART (SAE Controlled)
HINT:
Parameters listed in the chart may not be exactly the same as your reading due to the type of instrument or other
factors.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check mode, check the circuit for that code listed in the table
below. For details of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ”See page” for the respective ”DTC No.”
in the DTC chart.
DTC No.
(See page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL*
P0100
(DI–24)
Mass Air Flow Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
P0101
(DI–28)
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Range/ Performance Problem
Mass air flow meter
P0110
(DI–29)
Intake Air Temp. Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor
circuit
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM
P0115
(DI–33)
Engine Coolant Temp.
Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
P0116
(DI–37)
Engine Coolant Temp.
Circuit Range/ Performance Problem
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Cooling system
Throttle/ Pedal Position Sensor/Switch
”A” Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
Throttle/ Pedal Position Sensor/ Switch
”A” Circuit Range / Performance Problem
Throttle position sensor
Author:
Date:
Memory
27
IN–28
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
5.
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
The suspected circuits or parts for each problem symptom are shown in the table below. Use this table to
troubleshoot the problem when a ”Normal” code is displayed in the diagnostic trouble code check but the
problem is still occurring. Numbers in the table indicate the inspection order in which the circuits or parts
should be checked.
HINT:
When the problem is not detected by the diagnostic system even though the problem symptom is present,
it is considered that the problem is occurring outside the detection range of the diagnostic system, or that
the problem is occurring in a system other than the diagnostic system.
Page
Indicates the page where the flow chart for each circuit
is located.
Circuit Inspection, Inspection Order
Indicates the circuit which needs to be checked for each problem
symptom. Check in the order indicated by the numbers.
Problem Symptom
Circuit or Part Name
Indicates the circuit or part which needs to be checked.
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
See page
Suspect Area
Engine does not crank (Does not start)
1. Starter and starter relay
ST–2
ST–17
No initial combustion (Does not start)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Engine control module (ECM)
DI–147
DI–151
IN–29
No complete combustion (Does not start)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–151
Engine cranks normally (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Compression
DI–144
DI–151
EM–3
Cold engine (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–144
DI–151
Hot engine
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–144
DI–151
High engine idle speed (Poor idling)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
2. ECM power source circuit
AC–88
idling)
1. A/C signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
1. Compression
2. Fuel pump control circuit
Author:
Date:
28
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–29
6.
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
How to read and use each page is shown below.
Diagnostic Trouble Code No. and Detection Item
Circuit Description
The major role and operation, etc. of the circuit
and its component parts are explained.
DTC
P0325
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensor is fitted to the cylinder block to detect engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which
generates a voltage when it becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
DTC No.
P0325
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No knock sensor 1 signal to ECM with engine speed,
1,200 rpm or more.
Open or short in knock sensor1 circuit
Knock sensor 1 (looseness)
ECM
If the ECM detects the above diagnosis conditions, it operates the fall safe function in which the corrective retard angle
value is set to the maximum value.
Indicates the diagnostic trouble code, diagnostic
trouble code set parameter and suspect area of
the problem.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Knock Sensor 1
GR
12
KNK
E6
E1
Wiring Diagram
This shows a wiring diagram of the circuit.
Use this diagram together with ELECTRICAL
WIRING DIAGRAM to thoroughly understand the
circuit.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black, L = Blue, R = Red, BR = Brown,
LG = Light Green, V = Violet, G = Green,
O = Orange, W = White, GR = Gray, P = Pink,
Y = Yellow, SB = Sky Blue
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and
the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
V08423
Author:
Date:
29
IN–30
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
Indicates the position of the ignition switch during the check.
ON
LOCK
Ignition Switch ON
Ignition Switch LOCK (OFF)
START
ACC
Ignition Switch ACC
Ignition Switch START
Inspection Procedure
Use the inspection procedure to determine if
the circuit is normal or abnormal, and, if it is
abnormal, use it to determine whether the
problem is located in the sensors, actuators,
wire harness or ECU.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check continuity between terminal KNK of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–68).
(b) Disconnect the E6 connector of ECM.
LOCK
KNK
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal KNK of ECM connector
and body ground.
E6 Connector
AB0117
A00265
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
A00255
OK
Go to step 3.
NG
2
Check knock sensor (See page SF–61).
OK
Replace knock sensor.
Indicates the place to check the voltage or resistance.
Indicates the connector position to checked, from the front or back side.
Wire Harness
Check from the connector back side.
(with harness)
Check from the connector front side. (without harness)
In this case, care must be taken not to bend the terminals.
Indicates the condition of the connector of ECU during the check.
KNK
E6 Connector
E6 Connector
Connector being checked is connected.
KNK
Connector being checked is disconnected.
V08425
Author:
Date:
30
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–31
IN05X–05
HOW TO USE THE DIAGNOSTIC
CHART AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURE
1.
FI0046
FI0047
FI0048
CONNECTOR CONNECTION AND TERMINAL INSPECTION
For troubleshooting, diagnostic trouble code charts or
problem symptom table are provided for each circuit with
detailed inspection procedures on the following pages.
When all the component parts, wire harnesses and connectors of each circuit except the ECU are found to be
normal in troubleshooting, then it is determined that the
problem is in the ECU. Accordingly, if diagnosis is performed without the problem symptoms occurring, refer to
Step 8 to replace the ECU. So always confirm that the
problem symptoms are occurring, or proceed with inspection while using the symptom simulation method.
The instructions ”Check wire harness and connector” and
”Check and replace ECU” which appear in the inspection
procedure, are common and applicable to all diagnostic
trouble codes. Follow the procedure outlined below
whenever these instructions appear.
OPEN CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a disconnected wire harness, faulty contact in the connector, and a connector terminal pulled out, etc.
HINT:
It is rarely the case that a wire is broken in the middle of
it. Most cases occur at the connector. In particular, carefully check the connectors of sensors and actuators
Faulty contact could be due to rusting of the connector
terminals, to foreign materials entering terminals or a deformation of connector terminals. Simply disconnecting
and reconnecting the connectors once changes the
condition of the connection and may result in a return to
normal operation. Therefore, in troubleshooting, if no abnormality is found in the wire harness and connector
check, but the problem disappears after the check, then
the cause is considered to be in the wire harness or connectors.
SHORT CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a contact between wire harness and the
body ground or to a short circuit occurred inside the switch, etc.
HINT:
When there is a short circuit between the wire harness and body
ground, check thoroughly whether the wire harness is caught
in the body or is clamped properly.
Author:
Date:
31
IN–32
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
2.
CONNECTOR HANDLING
When inserting tester probes into a connector, insert them from
the rear of the connector. When necessary, use mini test leads.
For water resistant connectors which cannot be accessed from
behind, take good care not to deform the connector terminals.
FI7187
Sensor Side
3.
(a)
ECU Side
(b)
IN0379
CONTINUITY CHECK (OPEN CIRCUIT CHECK)
Disconnect the connectors at both ECU and sensor
sides.
Measure the resistance between the applicable terminals
of the connectors.
Resistance: 1 Ω or less
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the wire harness
vertically and horizontally.
ECU Side
Sensor Side
IN0378
4.
(a)
(b)
ECU Side
Sensor Side
IN0380
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the wire harness
vertically and horizontally.
5.
(a)
(b)
Pull Lightly
Looseness of Crimping
IN0381
RESISTANCE CHECK (SHORT CIRCUIT CHECK)
Disconnect the connectors on both ends.
Measure the resistance between the applicable terminals
of the connectors and body ground. Be sure to carry out
this check on the connectors on both ends.
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
(c)
VISUAL CHECK AND CONTACT PRESSURE CHECK
Disconnect the connectors at both ends.
Check for rust or foreign material, etc. in the terminals of
the connectors.
Check crimped portions for looseness or damage and
check that the terminals are secured in lock portion.
HINT:
The terminals should not come out when pulled lightly from the
back.
Author:
Date:
32
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–33
(d)
Prepare a test male terminal and insert it in the female terminal, then pull it out.
NOTICE:
When testing a gold–plated female terminal, always use a
gold–plated male terminal.
HINT:
When the test terminal is pulled out more easily than others,
there may be poor contact in that section.
Fig. 1
ECU
Sensor
C
B
1
2
OPEN
1
1
2
2
A
1
2
6.
CHECK OPEN CIRCUIT
For the open circuit in the wire harness in Fig. 1, perform ”(a)
Continuity Check” or ”(b) Voltage Check” to locate the section.
Z17004
(a)
Fig. 2
ECU
C
1
2
Sensor
B
1
2
A
1
2
Z17005
Fig. 3
ECU
Sensor
C
1
2
B2
1
2
B1
1
2
A
1
2
B04722
Check the continuity.
(1) Disconnect connectors ”A” and ”C” and measure
the resistance between them.
In the case of Fig. 2,
Between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and terminal 1
of connector ”C” → No continuity (open)
Between terminal 2 of connector ”A” and terminal 2
of connector ”C” → Continuity
Therefore, it is found out that there is an open circuit
between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and terminal 1
of connector ”C”.
(2) Disconnect connector ”B” and measure the resistance between them.
In the case of Fig. 3,
Between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and terminal 1
of connector ”B1” → Continuity
Between terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and terminal
1 of connector ”C” → No continuity (open)
Therefore, it is found out that there is an open circuit
between terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and terminal
1 of connector ”C”.
Author:
Date:
33
IN–34
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
(b)
Fig. 4
Sensor
5V
A
C
5V B
1
1 1
2
2
2
0V
5V
Z17007
7.
CHECK SHORT CIRCUIT
If the wire harness is ground shorted as in Fig. 5, locate the section by conducting a ”continuity check with ground”.
Fig. 5
C SHORT B
1
1
2
2
Check the voltage.
In a circuit in which voltage is applied (to the ECU connector terminal), an open circuit can be checked for by conducting a voltage check.
As shown in Fig. 4, with each connector still connected, measure the voltage between body ground
and terminal 1 of connector ”A” at the ECU 5V output terminal, terminal 1 of connector ”B”, and terminal 1 of connector ”C”, in that order.
If the results are:
5V: Between Terminal 1 of connector ”A” and Body Ground
5V: Between Terminal 1 of connector ”B” and Body Ground
0V: Between Terminal 1 of connector ”C” and Body Ground
Then it is found out that there is an open circuit in the wire harness between terminal 1 of ”B” and terminal 1 of ”C”.
A
1
2
Z17008
Fig. 6
ECU
Sensor
C
1
2
B
1
2
A
1
2
Z17009
Check the continuity with ground.
(1) Disconnect connectors ”A” and ”C” and measure
the resistance between terminal 1 and 2 of connector ”A” and body ground.
In the case of Fig. 6
Between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and body
ground → Continuity (short)
Between terminal 2 of connector ”A” and body
ground → No continuity
Therefore, it is found out that there is a short circuit
between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and terminal 1
of connector ”C”.
Author:
Date:
34
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–35
(2)
Fig. 7
Sensor
C
1
2
B2
1
2
B1
1
2
A
1
2
ECU
Z17808
Disconnect connector ”B” and measure the resistance between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and body
ground, and terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and body
ground.
Between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and body
ground → No continuity
Between terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and body
ground → Continuity (short)
Therefore, it is found out that there is a short circuit
between terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and terminal
1 of connector ”C”.
8.
CHECK AND REPLACE ECU
First check the ECU ground circuit. If it is faulty, repair it. If it is
normal, the ECU could be faulty, so replace the ECU with a normal functioning one and check that the symptoms appear.
(1)
Measure the resistance between the ECU ground
terminal and the body ground.
Resistance: 1 Ω or less
Example
Ground
IN0383
(2)
ECU Side
Disconnect the ECU connector, check the ground
terminals on the ECU side and the wire harness
side for bend and check the contact pressure.
Ground
W/H Side
Ground
IN0384
Author:
Date:
35
IN–36
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
TERMS
IN04Q–03
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL
Abbreviations
Meaning
ABS
Anti–Lock Brake System
AC
Alternating Current
ACC
Accessory
ACIS
Acoustic Control Induction System
ACSD
Automatic Cold Start Device
A.D.D.
Automatic Disconnecting Differential
A/F
Air–Fuel Ratio
AHC
Active Height Control Suspension
ALR
Automatic Locking Retractor
ALT
Alternator
AMP
Amplifier
ANT
Antenna
APPROX.
Approximately
A/T
Automatic Transmission (Transaxle)
ATF
Automatic Transmission Fluid
AUTO
Automatic
AUX
Auxiliary
AVG
Average
AVS
Adaptive Variable Suspension
BACS
Boost Altitude Compensation System
BAT
Battery
BDC
Bottom Dead Center
B/L
Bi–Level
B/S
Bore–Stroke Ratio
BTDC
Before Top Dead Center
BVSV
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve
Calif.
California
CB
Circuit Breaker
CCo
Catalytic Converter For Oxidation
CD
Compact Disc
CF
Cornering Force
CG
Center Of Gravity
CH
Channel
COMB.
Combination
CPE
Coupe
CPS
Combustion Pressure Sensor
CPU
Central Processing Unit
CRS
Child Restraint System
CTR
Center
C/V
Check Valve
CV
Control Valve
CW
Curb Weight
Author:
Date:
36
IN–37
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
DC
Direct Current
DEF
Defogger
DFL
Deflector
DIFF.
Differential
DIFF. LOCK
Differential Lock
D/INJ
Direct Injection
DLI
Distributorless Ignition
DOHC
Double Over Head Cam
DP
Dash Pot
DS
Dead Soak
DSP
Digital Signal Processor
ECAM
Engine Control And Measurement System
ECD
Electronic Controlled Diesel
ECDY
Eddy Current Dynamometer
ECU
Electronic Control Unit
ED
Electro–Deposited Coating
EDU
Electronic Driving Unit
EDIC
Electric Diesel Injection Control
EFI
Electronic Fuel Injection
E/G
Engine
EGR–VM
Egr–Vacuum Modulator
ELR
Emergency Locking Retractor
ENG
Engine
ESA
Electronic Spark Advance
ETCS
Electronic Throttle Control System
EVP
Evaporator
E–VRV
Electric Vacuum Regulating Valve
EXH
Exhaust
FE
Fuel Economy
FF
Front–Engine Front–Wheel–Drive
F/G
Fuel Gage
FIPG
Formed In Place Gasket
FL
Fusible Link
F/P
Fuel Pump
FPU
Fuel Pressure Up
Fr
Front
FR
Front–Engine Rear–Wheel–Drive
F/W
Flywheel
FW/D
Flywheel Damper
FWD
Front–Wheel–Drive
GAS
Gasoline
GND
Ground
HAC
High Altitude Compensator
H/B
Hatchback
H–FUSE
High Current Fuse
HI
High
Author:
Date:
37
IN–38
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
HID
High Intensity Discharge (Head Lamp)
HSG
Housing
HT
Hard Top
HWS
Heated Windshield System
IAC
Idle Air Control
IC
Integrated circuit
IDI
Indirect Diesel Injection
IFS
Independent Front Suspension
IG
Ignition
IIA
Integrated Ignition Assembly
IN
Intake (Manifold, Valve)
INT
Intermittent
I/P
Instrument Panel
IRS
Independent Rear Suspension
J/B
Junction Block
J/C
Junction Connector
KD
Kick–Down
LAN
Local Area Network
LB
Liftback
LCD
Liquid Crystal Display
LED
Light Emitting Diode
LH
Left–Hand
LHD
Left–Hand Drive
L/H/W
Length, Height, Width
LLC
Long–Life Coolant
LNG
Liquified Natural Gas
LO
Low
LPG
Liquified Petroleum Gas
LSD
Limited Slip Differential
LSP & PV
Load Sensing Proportioning And Bypass Valve
LSPV
Load Sensing Proportioning Valve
MAX.
Maximum
MIC
Microphone
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
MIN.
Minimum
MP
Multipurpose
MPX
Multiplex Communication System
M/T
Manual Transmission
MT
Mount
MTG
Mounting
N
Neutral
NA
Natural Aspiration
No.
Number
O/D
Overdrive
OEM
Original Equipment Manufacturing
OHC
Overhead Camshaft
Author:
Date:
38
IN–39
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
OHV
Overhead Valve
OPT
Option
O/S
Oversize
P & BV
Proportioning And Bypass Valve
PCS
Power Control System
PCV
Positive Crankcase Ventilation
PKB
Parking Brake
PPS
Progressive Power Steering
PS
Power Steering
PTO
Power Take–Off
R&P
Rack And Pinion
R/B
Relay Block
RBS
Recirculating Ball Type Steering
R/F
Reinforcement
RFS
Rigid Front Suspension
RRS
Rigid Rear Suspension
RH
Right–Hand
RHD
Right–Hand Drive
RLY
Relay
ROM
Read Only Memory
Rr
Rear
RR
Rear–Engine Rear–Wheel Drive
RWD
Rear–Wheel Drive
SDN
Sedan
SEN
Sensor
SICS
Starting Injection Control System
SOC
State Of Charge
SOHC
Single Overhead Camshaft
SPEC
Specification
SPI
Single Point Injection
SRS
Supplemental Restraint System
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
STD
Standard
STJ
Cold–Start Fuel Injection
SW
Switch
SYS
System
T/A
Transaxle
TACH
Tachometer
TBI
Throttle Body Electronic Fuel Injection
TC
Turbocharger
TCCS
TOYOTA Computer–Controlled System
TCV
Timing Control Valve
TDC
Top Dead Center
TEMP.
Temperature
TEMS
TOYOTA Electronic Modulated Suspension
Author:
Date:
39
IN–40
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
TIS
Total Information System For Vehicle Development
T/M
Transmission
TMC
TOYOTA Motor Corporation
TMMK
TOYOTA Motor Manufacturing Kentucky, Inc.
TRAC
Traction Control System
TURBO
Turbocharge
U/D
Underdrive
U/S
Undersize
VCV
Vacuum Control Valve
VENT
Ventilator
VIN
Vehicle Identification Number
VPS
Variable Power Steering
VSC
Vehicle Skid Control Vehicle Stability Control
VSV
Vacuum Switching Valve
VTV
Vacuum Transmitting Valve
w/
With
WGN
Wagon
W/H
Wire Harness
w/o
Without
1st
First
2nd
Second
2WD
Two Wheel Drive Vehicle (4x2)
4WD
Four Wheel Drive Vehicle (4x4)
Author:
Date:
40
IN–41
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
IN0CI–01
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
This glossary lists all SAE–J1930 terms and abbreviations used in this manual in compliance with SAE recommendations, as well as their TOYOTA equivalents.
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
TOYOTA TERMS
( )––ABBREVIATIONS
SAE TERMS
A/C
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner, A/CL
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
AP
Accelerator Pedal
B+
Battery Positive Voltage
+B, Battery Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
HAC
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
CL
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CMP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CPP
Clutch Pedal Position
–
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
–
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
LL ON, Idle ON
DFI
Direct Fuel Injection (Diesel)
Direct Injection (DI)
DI
Distributor Ignition
DLC1
DLC2
DLC3
Data Link Connector 1
Data Link Connector 2
Data Link Connector 3
1: Check Connector
2: Total Diagnosis Comunication Link (TDCL)
3: OBD II Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
–
ECL
Engine Control Level
–
ECM
Engine Control Module
Engine ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM),
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
EI
Electronic Ignition
TOYOTA Distributorless Ignition (TDI)
EM
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
EPROM
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
EVAP
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
FC
Fan Control
–
FEEPROM
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable
Read Only Memory
–
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
–
FF
Flexible Fuel
–
FP
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
GEN
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
–
–
–
Author:
Date:
41
IN–42
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
HO2S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
IAC
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
IFI
Indirect Fuel Injection
IFS
Inertia Fuel–Shutoff
–
ISC
Idle Speed Control
–
KS
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure
Intake Vacuum
MC
Mixture Control
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
MFI
Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Check Engine Lamp
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
–
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
–
NVRAM
Non–Volatile Random Access Memory
–
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, O2 Sensor (O2S)
OBD
On–Board Diagnostic
On–Board Diagnostic System (OBD)
OC
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalyst Convert (OC), CCo
OP
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
–
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
–
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
–
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
–
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
RAM
Random Access Memory
Random Access Memory (RAM)
RM
Relay Module
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
SC
Supercharger
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger Bypass
E–ABV
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
–
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
–
SRT
System Readiness Test
–
ST
Scan Tool
–
TB
Throttle Body
Throttle Body
TBI
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
TC
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
Torque Converter
–
Indirect Injection (IDL)
–
–
Author:
Date:
42
IN–43
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Transmission ECU, ECT ECU
TP
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TR
Transmission Range
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
TWC
Three–Way Catalytic Converter
Three–Way Catalytic (TWC)
Manifold Converter
CCRO
TWC+OC
Three–Way + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR + CCo
VAF
Volume Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
VR
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU–OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
–
WU–TWC
Warm Up Three–Way Catalytic Converter
–
3GR
Third Gear
–
4GR
Fourth Gear
–
–
Author:
Date:
43
IN–1
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
IN00U–30
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.
INDEX
An INDEX is provided on the first page of each section to guide you to the item to be repaired. To assist you
in finding your way through the manual, the Section Title and major heading are given at the top of every
page.
2.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
At the beginning of each section, a General Description is given that pertains to all repair operations contained in that section.
Read these precautions before starting any repair task.
3.
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING tables are included for each system to help you diagnose the problem and find the
cause. The fundamentals of how to proceed with troubleshooting are described on page IN–19.
Be sure to read this before performing troubleshooting.
4.
PREPARATION
Preparation lists the SST (Special Service Tools), recommended tools, equipment, lubricant and SSM (Special Service Materials) which should be prepared before beginning the operation and explains the purpose
of each one.
5.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
Most repair operations begin with an overview illustration. It identifies the components and shows how the
parts fit together.
Example:
Filler Cap
Float
Clevis Pin
Gasket
Reservoir Tank
Boot
Grommet
Slotted Spring Pin
Clip
12 (120, 9)
Clevis
15 (155, 11)
Snap Ring
Washer
Lock Nut
Push Rod
Piston
Cylinder
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
N17080
Author:
Date:
1
IN–2
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The procedures are presented in a step–by–step format:
The illustration shows what to do and where to do it.
The task heading tells what to do.
The detailed text tells how to perform the task and gives other information such as specifications
and warnings.
Example:
Task heading : what to do
21. CHECK PISTON STROKE OF OVERDRIVE BRAKE
(a) Place SST and a dial indicator onto the overdrive brake piston as shown in the illustration.
SST 09350–30020 (09350–06120)
Illustration:
what to do and where
Set part No.
Detailed text :
Component part No.
how to do task
(b) Measure the stroke applying and releasing the compressed
air (392 785 kPa, 4 8 kgf/cm 2 or 57 114 psi) as shown
in the illustration.
Piston stroke: 1.40
0.0669 in.)
1.70 mm (0.0551
Specification
This format provides the experienced technician with a FAST TRACK to the information needed. The upper
case task heading can be read at a glance when necessary, and the text below it provides detailed information. Important specifications and warnings always stand out in bold type.
6.
REFERENCES
References have been kept to a minimum. However, when they are required you are given the page to refer
to.
7.
SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications are presented in bold type throughout the text where needed. You never have to leave the
procedure to look up your specifications. They are also found in Service Specifications section, for quick
reference.
8.
CAUTIONS, NOTICES, HINTS:
CAUTIONS are presented in bold type, and indicate there is a possibility of injury to you or other
people.
NOTICES are also presented in bold type, and indicate the possibility of damage to the components
being repaired.
HINTS are separated from the text but do not appear in bold. They provide additional information to
help you perform the repair efficiently.
9.
SI UNIT
The UNITS given in this manual are primarily expressed according to the SI UNIT (International System of
Unit), and alternately expressed in the metric system and in the English System.
Example:
Torque: 30 N·m (310 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2
IN–3
INTRODUCTION
–
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
IN0CN–05
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION AND
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
1.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The vehicle identification number is stamped on the vehicle
identification number plate and the certification label, as shown
in the illustration.
A: Vehicle Identification Number Plate
B: Certification Label
A
B
B01453
2.
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
The engine serial number is stamped on the engine block, as
shown in the illustration.
5S–FNE engine:
B07931
Author:
Date:
3
IN–4
INTRODUCTION
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
IN0CO–07
GENERAL INFORMATION
FI1066
BASIC REPAIR HINT
(a) Use fender, seat and floor covers to keep the vehicle
clean and prevent damage.
(b) During disassembly, keep parts in the appropriate order
to facilitate reassembly.
(c) Installation and removal of battery terminal:
(1) Before performing electrical work, disconnect the
negative (–) terminal cable from the battery.
(2) If it is necessary to disconnect the battery for inspection or repair, first disconnect the negative (–)
terminal cable.
(3) When disconnecting the terminal cable, to prevent
damage to battery terminal, loosen the cable nut
and raise the cable straight up without twisting or
prying it.
(4) Clean the battery terminals and cable ends with a
clean shop rag. Do not scrape them with a file or other abrasive objects.
(5) Install the cable ends to the battery terminals after
loosening the nut, and tighten the nut after installation. Do not use a hammer to tap the cable ends
onto the terminals.
(6) Be sure the cover for the positive (+) terminal is
properly in place.
(d) Check hose and wiring connectors to make sure that they
are connected securely and correctly.
(e) Non–reusable parts
(1) Always replace cotter pins, gaskets, O–rings, oil
seals, etc. with new ones.
(2) Non–reusable parts are indicated in the component
illustrations by the ”” symbol.
(f)
Seal Lock Adhesive
Z11554
Precoated parts
Precoated parts are bolts, nuts, etc. that are coated with
a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(1) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
caused to move in any way, it must be recoated with
the specified adhesive.
(2) When reusing precoated parts, clean off the old
adhesive and dry with compressed air. Then apply
the specified seal lock adhesive to the bolt, nut or
threads.
Author:
Date:
4
IN–5
INTRODUCTION
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
(3)
(g)
(h)
(i)
Medium Current Fuse and High Current Fuse
Equal Amperage Rating
(j)
Precoated parts are indicated in the component illustrations by the ”” symbol.
When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to prevent
leaks.
Carefully observe all specifications for bolt tightening
torques. Always use a torque wrench.
Use of special service tools (SST) and special service materials (SSM) may be required, depending on the nature
of the repair. Be sure to use SST and SSM where specified and follow the proper work procedure. A list of SST
and SSM can be found in Preparation section in this
manual.
When replacing fuses, be sure the new fuse has the correct amperage rating. DO NOT exceed the rating or use
one with a lower rating.
BE1367
Illustration
Symbol
Part Name
Abbreviation
FUSE
FUSE
MEDIUM CURRENT FUSE
M–FUSE
HIGH CURRENT FUSE
H–FUSE
FUSIBLE LINK
FL
CIRCUIT BREAKER
CB
V00076
Author:
Date:
5
IN–6
INTRODUCTION
(k)
(l)
CORRECT
(3)
(4)
(5)
IN0253
(6)
WRONG
CORRECT
(7)
(8)
IN0252
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
Care must be taken when jacking up and supporting the
vehicle. Be sure to lift and support the vehicle at the proper locations (See page IN–8).
Cancel the parking brake on the level place and
shift the transmission in Neutral (or N position).
When jacking up the front wheels of the vehicle at
first place stoppers behind the rear wheels.
When jacking up the rear wheels of the vehicle at
first place stoppers before the front wheels.
When either the front or rear wheels only should be
jacked up, set rigid racks and place stoppers in front
and behind the other wheels on the ground.
After the vehicle is jacked up, be sure to support it
on rigid racks . It is extremely dangerous to do any
work on a vehicle raised on a jack alone, even for
a small job that can be finished quickly.
Observe the following precautions to avoid damage to the
following parts:
(1) Do not open the cover or case of the ECU unless
absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals are
touched, the IC may be destroyed by static electricity.)
(2)
WRONG
–
To disconnect vacuum hoses, pull off the end, not
the middle of the hose.
To pull apart electrical connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wires.
Be careful not to drop electrical components, such
as sensors or relays. If they are dropped on a hard
floor, they should be replaced and not reused.
When steam cleaning an engine, protect the electronic components, air filter and emission–related
components from water.
Never use an impact wrench to remove or install
temperature switches or temperature sensors.
When checking continuity at the wire connector, insert the tester probe carefully to prevent terminals
from bending.
When using a vacuum gauge, never force the hose
onto a connector that is too large. Use a step–down
adapter for adjustment. Once the hose has been
stretched, it may leak air.
Author:
Date:
6
IN–7
INTRODUCTION
(m)
Example
(n)
IN0002
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
Installation and removal of vacuum hose:
(1) When disconnecting vacuum hoses, use tags to
identify how they should be reconnected to.
(2) After completing a job, double check that the vacuum hoses are properly connected. A label under the
hood shows the proper layout.
Unless otherwise stated, all resistance is measured at an
ambient temperature of 20°C (68°F). Because the resistance may be outside specifications if measured at high
temperatures immediately after the vehicle has been running, measurement should be made when the engine has
cooled down.
Author:
Date:
7
IN–8
INTRODUCTION
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
IN0CP–05
VEHICLE LIFT AND SUPPORT LOCATIONS
Front
JACK POSITION
Front..................... Front crossmember
Rear..................... Rear axle beam
CAUTION : When jacking–up the rear and front, make
sure the car is not carrying any extra weight.
PANTOGRAPH JACK POSITION
SUPPORT POSITION
Safety stand and swing arm type lift ...........................................
N20619
IN–9
INTRODUCTION
–
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
PLATE TYPE LIFT
L
B
Attachment
A
C
HINT :
Left and right set position
Place the vehicle over the center of the lift.
Front and rear set position
Align the cushion gum ends of the plate
with the attachment lower ends (A, C).
Align the attachment upper end (B) with the
front jack supporting point (L).
Attachment dimensions
85 mm (3.35 in.)
70 mm (2.76 in.)
100 mm (3.94 in.)
200 mm (7.87 in.)
N20620
IN–10
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
IN0DW–01
PRECAUTION
1.
(a)
Negative Cable
BO4111
(b)
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH SRS AIRBAG AND
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
The 1999 CAMRY CNG is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), such as the driver airbag,
front passenger airbag assembly and seat belt pretensioner.
Failure to carry out service operations in the correct sequence could cause the supplemental restraint system to
unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to
a serious accident.
Further, if a mistake is made in servicing the supplemental
restraint system, it is possible the SRS may fail to operate
when required. Before servicing (including removal or
installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure
to read the following items carefully, then follow the correct procedure described in this manual.
GENERAL NOTICE
(1) Malfunction symptoms of the supplemental restraint system are difficult to confirm, so the diagnostic trouble codes become the most important
source of information when troubleshooting. When
troubleshooting the supplemental restraint system,
always inspect the diagnostic trouble codes before
disconnecting the battery (See page DI–223).
(2) Work must be started after 90 seconds from the
time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The supplemental restraint system is equipped
with a back–up power source so that if work is
started within 90 seconds of disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable from the battery, the SRS
may deploy.)
When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, memory of the clock and
audio systems will be cancelled. So before starting
work, make a record of the contents memorized by
the each memory system. Then when work is finished, reset the clock and audio systems as before.
To avoid erasing the memory of each memory system, never use a back–up power supply from another battery.
Author:
Date:
10
IN–11
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
(3)
Even in cases of a minor collision where the SRS
does not deploy, the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly and seat belt pretensioner
should be inspected (See Pub. No. RM654U on
page SR–16, RS–29 and BO–127).
(4) Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
(5) Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor if shocks
are likely to be applied to the sensor during repairs.
(6) Never disassemble and repair the airbag sensor assembly, steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag
assembly or seat belt pretensioner.
(7) If the airbag sensor assembly, steering wheel pad,
front passenger airbag assembly or seat belt pretensioner has been dropped, or if there are cracks,
dents or other defects in the case, bracket or connector, replace them with new ones.
(8) Do not directly expose the airbag sensor assembly,
steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly or seat belt pretensioner to hot air or flames.
(9) Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V
minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical circuit.
(10) Information labels are attached to the periphery of
the SRS components. Follow the instructions on the
notices.
(11) After work on the supplemental restraint system is
completed, check the SRS warning light (See page
DI–223).
(c)
Marks
SPIRAL CABLE (in Combination Switch)
The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the steering
column with the spiral cable at the neutral position, otherwise cable disconnection and other troubles may result.
Refer to 1999 CAMRY REPAIR MANUAL (Pub. No.
RM654U on page SR–16) concerning correct steering
wheel installation.
W02655
Author:
Date:
11
IN–12
INTRODUCTION
(d)
Example:
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
STEERING WHEEL PAD (with Airbag)
(1) When removing the steering wheel pad or handling
a new steering wheel pad, it should be placed with
the pad top surface facing up.
In this case, the twin–lock type connector lock lever
should be in the locked state and care should be
taken to place it so the connector will not be damaged. In addition do not store a steering wheel pad
on top of another one. Storing the pad with its metallic surface up may lead to a serious accident if the
airbag inflates for some reason.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
(3) Grease should not be applied to the steering wheel
pad and the pad should not be cleaned with detergents of any kind.
(4) Store the steering wheel pad where the ambient
temperature remains below 93°C (200°F), without
high humidity and away from electrical noise.
(5) When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) under the
steering column near the combination switch connector before starting work.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the steering wheel
pad alone, the airbag should be deployed using an
SST before disposal (See Pub. No. RM654U on
page RS–18).
Carry out the operation in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
Correct
Wrong
Z13953
Example:
Z13950
Author:
Date:
12
IN–13
INTRODUCTION
(e)
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Always store a removed or new front passenger airbag assembly with the airbag deployment direction
facing up.
Storing the airbag assembly with the airbag deployment direction facing down could cause a serious
accident if the airbag inflates.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib.
(This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
(3) Grease should not be applied to the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag door should not
be cleaned with detergents of any kind.
(4) Store the airbag assembly where the ambient temperature remains below 93°C (200°F), without high
humidity and away from electrical noise.
(5) When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) installed on
the assembly before starting work.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the airbag assembly
alone, the airbag should be deployed using an SST
before disposal (See Pub. No. RM654U on page
RS–31).
Perform the operation in a safe place away from
electrical noise.
Example:
Correct
Wrong
B00696
Example:
Z13951
Author:
Date:
13
IN–14
INTRODUCTION
(f)
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
(1) Never measure the resistance of the seat belt pretensioner. (This may cause the seat belt pretensioner to activate, which is very dangerous.)
(2) Never disassemble the seat belt pretensioner.
(3) Never install the seat belt pretensioner in another
vehicle.
(4) Store the seat belt pretensioner where the ambient
temperature remains below 80°C (176°F) and
away from electrical noise without high humidity.
(5) When using electric welding, first disconnect the
connector (yellow color and 2 pins) before starting
work.
(6) When disposing of a vehicle or the seat belt pretensioner alone, the seat belt pretensioner should be
activated before disposal (See Pub. No. RM654U
on page BO–128). Perform the operation in a safe
place away from electrical noise.
(7) The seat belt pretensioner is hot after activation, so
let it cool down sufficiently before the disposal.
However never apply water to the seat belt pretensioner.
Example:
B02121
Author:
Date:
14
IN–15
INTRODUCTION
(g)
(h)
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(1) Never reuse the airbag sensor assembly involved
in a collision when the SRS has deployed.
(2) The connectors to the airbag sensor assembly
should be connected or disconnected with the sensor mounted on the floor. If the connectors are connected or disconnected while the airbag sensor assembly is not mounted to the floor, it could cause
undesired ignition of the supplemental restraint system.
(3) Work must be started after 90 seconds from the
time the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, even if only loosing the set
bolts of the airbag sensor assembly.
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
The SRS wire harness is integrated with the instrument
panel wire harness assembly. All the connectors in the
system are a standard yellow color. If the SRS wire harness becomes disconnected or the connector becomes
broken due to an accident, etc., repair or replace it as
shown on page RS–73 in Pub. No. RM654U .
Author:
Date:
15
IN–16
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
2.
FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A CATALYTIC CONVERTER
CAUTION:
If large amount of unburned compressed neutral gas (CNG) flows into the converter, it may overheat
and create a fire hazard. To prevent this, observe the following precautions and explain them to your
customer.
(a) Use only unleaded compressed neutral gas (CNG).
(b) Avoid prolonged idling.
Avoid running the engine at idle speed for more than 20 minutes.
(c) Avoid spark jump test.
(1) Perform spark jump test only when absolutely necessary. Perform this test as rapidly as possible.
(2) While testing, never race the engine.
(d) Avoid prolonged engine compression measurement.
Engine compression tests must be done as rapidly as possible.
(e) Do not run engine when fuel tank is nearly empty.
This may cause the engine to misfire and create an extra load on the converter.
(f)
Avoid coasting with ignition turned off.
(g) Do not dispose of used catalyst along with parts contaminated with neutral gas or oil.
3.
IF VEHICLE IS EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
For vehicles with mobile communication systems such as two–way radios and cellular telephones, observe
the following precautions.
(1) Install the antenna as far as possible away from the ECU and sensors of the vehicle’s electronic
system.
(2) Install the antenna feeder at least 20 cm (7.87 in.) away from the ECU and sensors of the vehicle’s electronic systems. For details about ECU and sensors locations, refer to the section on
the applicable component.
(3) Avoid winding the antenna feeder together with other wiring as much as possible, and also avoid
running the antenna feeder parallel with other wire harnesses.
(4) Check that the antenna and feeder are correctly adjusted.
(5) Do not install powerful mobile communications system.
Author:
Date:
16
IN–17
INTRODUCTION
–
FOR ALL OF VEHICLES
4.
FOR USING OBD II SCAN TOOL OR HAND–HELD TESTER
CAUTION:
Observe the following items for safety reasons:
Before using the OBD II scan tool or hand–held tester, the OBD II scan tool’s instruction book
or hand–held tester’s operator manual should be read thoroughly.
Be sure to route all cables securely when driving with the OBD II scan tool or hand–held tester
connected to the vehicle. (i.e. Keep cables away from feet, pedals, steering wheel and shift lever.)
Two persons are required when test driving with the OBD II scan tool or hand–held tester, one
person to drive the vehicle and the other person to operate the OBD II scan tool or hand–held
tester.
Author:
Date:
17
IN–18
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN05Y–10
GENERAL INFORMATION
A large number of ECU controlled systems are used in the 1999 CAMRY CNG. In general, the ECU controlled system is considered to be a very intricate system requiring a high level of technical knowledge and
expert skill to troubleshoot. However, the fact is that if you proceed to inspect the circuits one by one, troubleshooting of these systems is not complex. If you have adequate understanding of the system and a basic
knowledge of electricity, accurate diagnosis and necessary repair can be performed to locate and fix the
problem. This manual is designed through emphasis of the above standpoint to help service technicians
perform accurate and effective troubleshooting, and is compiled for the following major ECU controlled systems:
The troubleshooting procedure and how to make use of it are described on the following pages.
1. Engine
DI–1
2. Automatic Transaxle
DI–131
3. Anti–Lock Brake System
DI–175
4. Supplemental Restraint System
DI–221
5. Cruise Control System
DI–317
FOR USING OBD II SCAN TOOL OR HAND–HELD TESTER
Before using the scan tool or tester, the scan tool’s instruction book or tester’s operator manual should
be read thoroughly.
If the scan tool or tester cannot communicate with ECU controlled systems when you have connected
the cable of the scan tool or tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON and operated the scan tool,
there is a problem on the vehicle side or tool side.
(1) If communication is normal when the tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect the diagnosis
data link line (Busline) or ECU power circuit of the vehicle.
(2) If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tool itself, so perform the Self Test procedures outline in the Tester Operator’s
Manual.
Author:
Date:
18
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–19
IN05W–12
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
Carry out troubleshooting in accordance with the procedure on the following page. Here, only the basic procedure is shown. Details are provided in Diagnostics section, showing the most effective methods for each
circuit. Confirm the troubleshooting procedures first for the relevant circuit before beginning troubleshooting
of that circuit.
Vehicle Brought to Workshop
1
2
1
Ask the customer about the conditions and the
environment when the problem occurred.
Customer Problem
Analysis
Symptom Confirmation
and Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
3
Symptom Simulation
2, 3
Confirm the symptoms and the problem conditions,
and check the diagnostic trouble codes.
(When the problem symptoms do not appear
during confirmation, use the symptom simulation
method described later on.)
4
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Chart
5
6
Problem Symptoms Table
Circuit Inspection or Parts
Inspection
7
Repair
8
Confirmation Test
End
4, 5, 6
Check the results obtained in Step 2, then confirm
the inspection procedure for the system or the part
which should be checked using the diagnostic
trouble code chart or the problem symptoms table.
7
Check and repair the affected system or part in
accordance with the instructions in Step 6.
8
After completing repairs, confirm that the problem
has been eliminated.
(If the problem is not reproduced, perform the
confirmation test under the same conditions and
in the same environment as when it occurred for
the first time.)
IN–20
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
1.
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
In troubleshooting, the problem symptoms must be confirmed accurately and all preconceptions must be
cleared away in order to give an accurate judgment. To ascertain just what the problem symptoms are, it is
extremely important to ask the customer about the problem and the conditions at the time it occurred.
Important Point in the Problem Analysis:
The following 5 items are important points in the problem analysis. Past problems which are thought to be
unrelated and the repair history, etc. may also help in some cases, so as much information as possible should
be gathered and its relationship with the problem symptoms should be correctly ascertained for reference
in troubleshooting. A customer problem analysis table is provided in Diagnostics section for each system
for your use.
Important Points in the Customer Problem Analysis
What ––––– Vehicle model, system name
When ––––– Date, time, occurrence frequency
Where ––––– Road conditions
Under what conditions? ––––– Running conditions, driving conditions, weather conditions
How did it happen? ––––– Problem symptoms
(Sample) Engine control system check sheet.
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM Check Sheet
Inspector’s
Name
Model and Model
Year
Driver’s Name
Frame No.
Data Vehicle
Brought in
Engine Model
License No.
Odometer Reading
Problem Symptoms
Customer’s Name
Engine does
not Start
Engine does not crank
Difficult to
Start
Engine cranks slowly
Other
Poor Idling
Incorrect first idle
Idling rpm is abnormal
Rough idling
Other
Poor
Drive ability
Hesitation
Knocking
Engine Stall
Soon after starting
After accelerator pedal depressed
After accelerator pedal released
During A/C operation
Shifting from N to D
Other
No initial combustion
Back fire
Other
High (
Muffler explosion (after–fire)
Others
Data Problem
Constant
Sometimes (
times per
day/month)
km
miles
No complete combustion
rpm)
Low (
Surging
rpm)
INTRODUCTION
–
IN–21
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
2.
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK
The diagnostic system in the 1999 CAMRY CNG fulfills various functions. The first function is the Diagnostic
Trouble Code Check in which a malfunction in the signal circuits to the ECU is stored in code in the ECU
memory at the time of occurrence, to be output by the technician during troubleshooting. Another function
is the Input Signal Check which checks if the signals from various switches are sent to the ECU correctly.
By using these check functions, the problem areas can be narrowed down quickly and troubleshooting can
be performed effectively. Diagnostic functions are incorporated in the following systems in the 1999 CAMRY
CNG.
System
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
Input Signal Check
(Sensor Check)
Diagnostic Test
Mode (Active Test)
(with Check
Mode)
(with Check
Mode)
Engine
Automatic Transaxle
Anti–Lock Brake System
Supplemental Restraint System
Cruise Control System
In diagnostic trouble code check, it is very important to determine whether the problem indicated by the diagnostic trouble code is still occurring or occurred in the past but returned to normal at present. In addition,
it must be checked in the problem symptom check whether the malfunction indicated by the diagnostic
trouble code is directly related to the problem symptom or not. For this reason, the diagnostic trouble codes
should be checked before and after the symptom confirmation to determine the current conditions, as shown
in the table below. If this is not done, it may, depending on the case, result in unnecessary troubleshooting
for normally operating systems, thus making it more difficult to locate the problem, or in repairs not pertinent
to the problem. Therefore, always follow the procedure in correct order and perform the diagnostic trouble
code check.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHECK PROCEDURE
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check (Make a
note of and then clear)
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Display
Confirmation
of Symptoms
Diagnostic Trouble
Code Check
Problem symptoms Same diagnostic
trouble code is
exist
displayed
Normal code is
displayed
Normal Code Display
Problem Condition
Problem is still occurring in the diagnostic
circuit
The problem is still occurring in a place
other than in the diagnostic circuit
(The diagnostic trouble code displayed
first is either for a past problem or it is a
secondary problem)
No problem
symptoms exist
The problem occurred in the diagnostic
circuit in the past
Problem symptoms Normal code is
exist
displayed
The problem is still occurring in a place
other than in the diagnostic circuit
No problem
symptoms exist
The problem occurred in a place other
than in the diagnostic circuit in the past
Normal code is
displayed
IN–22
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
Taking into account the points on the previous page, a flow chart showing how to proceed with troubleshooting using the diagnostic trouble code check is shown below. This flow chart shows how to utilize the diagnostic trouble code check effectively, then by carefully checking the results, indicates how to proceed either to
diagnostic trouble code troubleshooting or to troubleshooting of problem symptoms table.
Diagnostic trouble code check
Making a note of and clearing of the diagnostic trouble codes displayed
Symptom confirmation
Problem symptoms
exist
No problem symptoms
exist
Simulation test using the symptom
simulation methods
Diagnostic trouble code check
Diagnostic trouble code displayed
Problem symptoms exist
Normal code displayed
Problem symptoms exist
Troubleshooting of problem indicated
by diagnostic trouble code
Troubleshooting of each
problem symptom
Normal code displayed
No problem symptoms exist
System Normal
If a diagnostic trouble code was
displayed in the initial diagnostic
trouble code check, it indicates
that the trouble may have occurred
in a wire harness or connector in
that circuit in the past. Therefore,
check the wire harness and connectors (See page IN–29).
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–23
3.
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when there are no problem symptoms occurring. In such cases,
a thorough customer problem analysis must be carried out, then simulate the same or similar conditions and
environment in which the problem occurred in the customer’s vehicle. No matter how much experience a
technician has, or how skilled he may be, if he proceeds to troubleshoot without confirming the problem
symptoms he will tend to overlook something important in the repair operation and make a wrong guess
somewhere, which will only lead to a standstill. For example, for a problem which only occurs when the engine is cold, or for a problem which occurs due to vibration caused by the road during driving, etc., the problem can never be determined so long as the symptoms are confirmed with the engine hot condition or the
vehicle at a standstill. Since vibration, heat or water penetration (moisture) is likely cause for problem which
is difficult to reproduce, the symptom simulation tests introduced here are effective measures in that the external causes are applied to the vehicle in a stopped condition.
Important Points in the Symptom Simulation Test:
In the symptom simulation test, the problem symptoms should of course be confirmed, but the problem area
or parts must also be found out. To do this, narrow down the possible problem circuits according to the symptoms before starting this test and connect a tester beforehand. After that, carry out the symptom simulation
test, judging whether the circuit being tested is defective or normal and also confirming the problem symptoms at the same time. Refer to the problem symptoms table for each system to narrow down the possible
causes of the symptom.
1
VIBRATION METHOD: When vibration seems to be the major cause.
CONNECTORS
Slightly shake the connector vertically and horizontally.
Shake Slightly
WIRE HARNESS
Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and horizontally.
The connector joint, fulcrum of the vibration, and body
through portion are the major areas to be checked thoroughly.
Swing Slightly
PARTS AND SENSOR
Vibrate Slightly
Apply slight vibration with a finger to the part of the sensor
considered to be the problem cause and check that the malfunction occurs.
HINT:
Applying strong vibration to relays may result in open relays.
V07268
IN–24
2
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
HEAT METHOD: When the problem seems to occur when the suspect area is heated.
Heat the component that is the likely cause of the malfunction
with a hair dryer or similar object. Check to see if the malfunction
occurs.
M a l f u n ction
NOTICE:
(1) Do not heat to more than 60 °C (140 °F). (Temperature
is limited not to damage the components.)
(2) Do not apply heat directly to parts in the ECU.
3
WATER SPRINKLING METHOD: When the malfunction seems to occur on a rainy day or in a
high–humidity condition.
Sprinkle water onto the vehicle and check to see if the malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
(1) Never sprinkle water directly into the engine compartment, but indirectly change the temperature and humidity by applying water spray onto the radiator front
surface.
(2) Never apply water directly onto the electronic components.
HINT:
If a vehicle is subject to water leakage, the leaked water may
contaminate the ECU. When testing a vehicle with a water leakage problem, special caution must be taken.
4
OTHER: When a malfunction seems to occur when electrical load is excessive.
Turn on all electrical loads including the heater blower, head
lights, rear window defogger, etc. and check to see if the malfunction occurs.
ON
B02389
B02390
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–25
4.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
The inspection procedure is shown in the table below. This table permits efficient and accurate troubleshooting using the diagnostic trouble codes displayed in the diagnostic trouble code check. Proceed with troubleshooting in accordance with the inspection procedure given in the diagnostic chart corresponding to the
diagnostic trouble codes displayed. The engine diagnostic trouble code chart is shown below as an example.
DTC No.
Indicates the diagnostic trouble code.
Page or Instructions
Indicates the page where the inspection procedure
for each circuit is to be found, or gives instructions
for checking and repairs.
Trouble Area
Indicates the suspect area of the
problem.
Detection Item
Indicates the system of the problem or
contents of the problem.
DTC CHART (SAE Controlled)
HINT:
Parameters listed in the chart may not be exactly the same as your reading due to the type of instrument or other
factors.
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check mode, check the circuit for that code listed in the table
below. For details of each code, turn to the page referred to under the ”See page” for the respective ”DTC No.”
in the DTC chart.
DTC No.
(See page)
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P0100
(DI–24)
Mass Air Flow Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
P0101
(DI–28)
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Range/ Performance Problem
Mass air flow meter
P0110
(DI–29)
Intake Air Temp. Circuit
Malfunction
Open or short in intake air temp. sensor
circuit
Intake air temp. sensor
ECM
P0115
(DI–33)
Engine Coolant Temp.
Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in engine coolant temp. sensor circuit
Engine coolant temp. sensor
ECM
P0116
(DI–37)
Engine Coolant Temp.
Circuit Range/ Performance Problem
Engine coolant temp. sensor
Cooling system
Throttle/ Pedal Position Sensor/Switch
”A” Circuit Malfunction
Open or short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
Throttle/ Pedal Position Sensor/ Switch
”A” Circuit Range / Performance Problem
Throttle position sensor
MIL*
Memory
IN–26
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
5.
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
The suspected circuits or parts for each problem symptom are shown in the table below. Use this table to
troubleshoot the problem when a ”Normal” code is displayed in the diagnostic trouble code check but the
problem is still occurring. Numbers in the table indicate the inspection order in which the circuits or parts
should be checked.
HINT:
When the problem is not detected by the diagnostic system even though the problem symptom is present,
it is considered that the problem is occurring outside the detection range of the diagnostic system, or that
the problem is occurring in a system other than the diagnostic system.
Page
Indicates the page where the flow chart for each circuit
is located.
Circuit Inspection, Inspection Order
Indicates the circuit which needs to be checked for each problem
symptom. Check in the order indicated by the numbers.
Problem Symptom
Circuit or Part Name
Indicates the circuit or part which needs to be checked.
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Engine does not crank (Does not start)
1. Starter and starter relay
ST–2
ST–17
No initial combustion (Does not start)
1. ECM power source circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Engine control module (ECM)
DI–147
DI–151
IN–29
No complete combustion (Does not start)
1. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–151
Engine cranks normally (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
3. Compression
DI–144
DI–151
EM–3
Cold engine (Difficult to start)
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–144
DI–151
Hot engine
1. Starter signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
DI–144
DI–151
High engine idle speed (Poor idling)
1. A/C signal circuit (Compressor circuit)
2. ECM power source circuit
AC–88
idling)
1. A/C signal circuit
2. Fuel pump control circuit
1. Compression
2. Fuel pump control circuit
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–27
6.
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
How to read and use each page is shown below.
Diagnostic Trouble Code No. and Detection Item
Circuit Description
The major role and operation, etc. of the circuit
and its component parts are explained.
DTC
P0325
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensor is fitted to the cylinder block to detect engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which
generates a voltage when it becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
DTC No.
P0325
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
No knock sensor 1 signal to ECM with engine speed,
1,200 rpm or more.
Open or short in knock sensor1 circuit
Knock sensor 1 (looseness)
ECM
If the ECM detects the above diagnosis conditions, it operates the fall safe function in which the corrective retard angle
value is set to the maximum value.
Indicates the diagnostic trouble code, diagnostic
trouble code set parameter and suspect area of
the problem.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Knock Sensor 1
GR
12
KNK
E6
E1
Wiring Diagram
This shows a wiring diagram of the circuit.
Use this diagram together with ELECTRICAL
WIRING DIAGRAM to thoroughly understand the
circuit.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black, L = Blue, R = Red, BR = Brown,
LG = Light Green, V = Violet, G = Green,
O = Orange, W = White, GR = Gray, P = Pink,
Y = Yellow, SB = Sky Blue
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and
the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
V08423
IN–28
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
Indicates the position of the ignition switch during the check.
ON
LOCK
Ignition Switch ON
Ignition Switch LOCK (OFF)
START
ACC
Ignition Switch ACC
Ignition Switch START
Inspection Procedure
Use the inspection procedure to determine if
the circuit is normal or abnormal, and, if it is
abnormal, use it to determine whether the
problem is located in the sensors, actuators,
wire harness or ECU.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
Check continuity between terminal KNK of ECM connector and body ground.
PREPARATION:
(a) Remove the glove compartment (See page SF–68).
(b) Disconnect the E6 connector of ECM.
LOCK
KNK
CHECK:
Measure resistance between terminal KNK of ECM connector
and body ground.
E6 Connector
AB0117
A00265
OK:
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
A00255
OK
Go to step 3.
NG
2
Check knock sensor (See page SF–61).
OK
Replace knock sensor.
Indicates the place to check the voltage or resistance.
Indicates the connector position to checked, from the front or back side.
Wire Harness
Check from the connector back side.
(with harness)
Check from the connector front side. (without harness)
In this case, care must be taken not to bend the terminals.
Indicates the condition of the connector of ECU during the check.
KNK
E6 Connector
Connector being checked is connected.
KNK
E6 Connector
Connector being checked is disconnected.
V08425
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–29
IN05X–10
HOW TO USE THE DIAGNOSTIC
CHART AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURE
1.
FI0046
FI0047
FI0048
CONNECTOR CONNECTION AND TERMINAL INSPECTION
For troubleshooting, diagnostic trouble code charts or
problem symptom table are provided for each circuit with
detailed inspection procedures on the following pages.
When all the component parts, wire harnesses and connectors of each circuit except the ECU are found to be
normal in troubleshooting, then it is determined that the
problem is in the ECU. Accordingly, if diagnosis is performed without the problem symptoms occurring, refer to
Step 8 to replace the ECU. So always confirm that the
problem symptoms are occurring, or proceed with inspection while using the symptom simulation method.
The instructions ”Check wire harness and connector” and
”Check and replace ECU” which appear in the inspection
procedure, are common and applicable to all diagnostic
trouble codes. Follow the procedure outlined below
whenever these instructions appear.
OPEN CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a disconnected wire harness, faulty contact in the connector, and a connector terminal pulled out, etc.
HINT:
It is rarely the case that a wire is broken in the middle of
it. Most cases occur at the connector. In particular, carefully check the connectors of sensors and actuators
Faulty contact could be due to rusting of the connector
terminals, to foreign materials entering terminals or a deformation of connector terminals. Simply disconnecting
and reconnecting the connectors once changes the
condition of the connection and may result in a return to
normal operation. Therefore, in troubleshooting, if no abnormality is found in the wire harness and connector
check, but the problem disappears after the check, then
the cause is considered to be in the wire harness or connectors.
SHORT CIRCUIT:
This could be due to a contact between wire harness and the
body ground or to a short circuit occurred inside the switch, etc.
HINT:
When there is a short circuit between the wire harness and body
ground, check thoroughly whether the wire harness is caught
in the body or is clamped properly.
IN–30
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
2.
CONNECTOR HANDLING
When inserting tester probes into a connector, insert them from
the rear of the connector. When necessary, use mini test leads.
For water resistant connectors which cannot be accessed from
behind, take good care not to deform the connector terminals.
FI7187
Sensor Side
3.
(a)
ECU Side
(b)
IN0379
CONTINUITY CHECK (OPEN CIRCUIT CHECK)
Disconnect the connectors at both ECU and sensor
sides.
Measure the resistance between the applicable terminals
of the connectors.
Resistance: 1 Ω or less
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the wire harness
vertically and horizontally.
ECU Side
Sensor Side
IN0378
4.
(a)
(b)
ECU Side
Sensor Side
IN0380
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the wire harness
vertically and horizontally.
5.
(a)
(b)
Pull Lightly
Looseness of Crimping
IN0381
RESISTANCE CHECK (SHORT CIRCUIT CHECK)
Disconnect the connectors on both ends.
Measure the resistance between the applicable terminals
of the connectors and body ground. Be sure to carry out
this check on the connectors on both ends.
Resistance: 1 MΩ or higher
(c)
VISUAL CHECK AND CONTACT PRESSURE CHECK
Disconnect the connectors at both ends.
Check for rust or foreign material, etc. in the terminals of
the connectors.
Check crimped portions for looseness or damage and
check that the terminals are secured in lock portion.
HINT:
The terminals should not come out when pulled lightly from the
back.
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–31
(d)
Prepare a test male terminal and insert it in the female terminal, then pull it out.
NOTICE:
When testing a gold–plated female terminal, always use a
gold–plated male terminal.
HINT:
When the test terminal is pulled out more easily than others,
there may be poor contact in that section.
Fig. 1
ECU
Sensor
C
B
1
2
OPEN
1
1
2
2
A
1
2
6.
CHECK OPEN CIRCUIT
For the open circuit in the wire harness in Fig. 1, perform ”(a)
Continuity Check” or ”(b) Voltage Check” to locate the section.
Z17004
(a)
Fig. 2
ECU
C
1
2
Sensor
B
1
2
A
1
2
Z17005
Fig. 3
ECU
Sensor
C
1
2
B2
1
2
B1
1
2
A
1
2
B04722
Check the continuity.
(1) Disconnect connectors ”A” and ”C” and measure
the resistance between them.
In the case of Fig. 2,
Between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and terminal 1
of connector ”C” → No continuity (open)
Between terminal 2 of connector ”A” and terminal 2
of connector ”C” → Continuity
Therefore, it is found out that there is an open circuit
between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and terminal 1
of connector ”C”.
(2) Disconnect connector ”B” and measure the resistance between the connectors.
In the case of Fig. 3,
Between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and terminal 1
of connector ”B1” → Continuity
Between terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and terminal
1 of connector ”C” → No continuity (open)
Therefore, it is found out that there is an open circuit
between terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and terminal
1 of connector ”C”.
IN–32
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
(b)
Fig. 4
Sensor
5V
A
C
5V B
1
1 1
2
2
2
0V
5V
Z17007
7.
CHECK SHORT CIRCUIT
If the wire harness is ground shorted as in Fig. 5, locate the section by conducting a ”continuity check with ground”.
Fig. 5
C SHORT B
1
1
2
2
Check the voltage.
In a circuit in which voltage is applied (to the ECU connector terminal), an open circuit can be checked for by conducting a voltage check.
As shown in Fig. 4, with each connector still connected, measure the voltage between body ground
and terminal 1 of connector ”A” at the ECU 5V output terminal, terminal 1 of connector ”B”, and terminal 1 of connector ”C”, in that order.
If the results are:
5V: Between Terminal 1 of connector ”A” and Body Ground
5V: Between Terminal 1 of connector ”B” and Body Ground
0V: Between Terminal 1 of connector ”C” and Body Ground
Then it is found out that there is an open circuit in the wire harness between terminal 1 of ”B” and terminal 1 of ”C”.
A
1
2
Z17008
Fig. 6
ECU
Sensor
C
1
2
B
1
2
A
1
2
Z17009
Check the continuity with ground.
(1) Disconnect connectors ”A” and ”C” and measure
the resistance between terminal 1 and 2 of connector ”A” and body ground.
In the case of Fig. 6
Between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and body
ground → Continuity (short)
Between terminal 2 of connector ”A” and body
ground → No continuity
Therefore, it is found out that there is a short circuit
between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and terminal 1
of connector ”C”.
INTRODUCTION
–
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED
SYSTEMS
IN–33
(2)
Fig. 7
Sensor
C
1
2
B2
1
2
B1
1
2
A
1
2
ECU
Z17808
Disconnect connector ”B” and measure the resistance between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and body
ground, and terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and body
ground.
Between terminal 1 of connector ”A” and body
ground → No continuity
Between terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and body
ground → Continuity (short)
Therefore, it is found out that there is a short circuit
between terminal 1 of connector ”B2” and terminal
1 of connector ”C”.
8.
CHECK AND REPLACE ECU
First check the ECU ground circuit. If it is faulty, repair it. If it is
normal, the ECU could be faulty, so replace the ECU with a normal functioning one and check that the symptoms appear.
(1)
Measure the resistance between the ECU ground
terminal and the body ground.
Resistance: 1 Ω or less
Example
Ground
IN0383
(2)
ECU Side
Ground
W/H Side
Ground
IN0384
Disconnect the ECU connector, check the ground
terminals on the ECU side and the wire harness
side for bend and check the contact pressure.
IN–34
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
TERMS
IN04Q–03
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS MANUAL
Abbreviations
Meaning
ABS
Anti–Lock Brake System
AC
Alternating Current
ACC
Accessory
ACIS
Acoustic Control Induction System
ACSD
Automatic Cold Start Device
A.D.D.
Automatic Disconnecting Differential
A/F
Air–Fuel Ratio
AHC
Active Height Control Suspension
ALR
Automatic Locking Retractor
ALT
Alternator
AMP
Amplifier
ANT
Antenna
APPROX.
Approximately
A/T
Automatic Transmission (Transaxle)
ATF
Automatic Transmission Fluid
AUTO
Automatic
AUX
Auxiliary
AVG
Average
AVS
Adaptive Variable Suspension
BACS
Boost Altitude Compensation System
BAT
Battery
BDC
Bottom Dead Center
B/L
Bi–Level
B/S
Bore–Stroke Ratio
BTDC
Before Top Dead Center
BVSV
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve
Calif.
California
CB
Circuit Breaker
CCo
Catalytic Converter For Oxidation
CD
Compact Disc
CF
Cornering Force
CG
Center Of Gravity
CH
Channel
COMB.
Combination
CPE
Coupe
CPS
Combustion Pressure Sensor
CPU
Central Processing Unit
CRS
Child Restraint System
CTR
Center
C/V
Check Valve
CV
Control Valve
CW
Curb Weight
Author:
Date:
34
IN–35
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
DC
Direct Current
DEF
Defogger
DFL
Deflector
DIFF.
Differential
DIFF. LOCK
Differential Lock
D/INJ
Direct Injection
DLI
Distributorless Ignition
DOHC
Double Over Head Cam
DP
Dash Pot
DS
Dead Soak
DSP
Digital Signal Processor
ECAM
Engine Control And Measurement System
ECD
Electronic Controlled Diesel
ECDY
Eddy Current Dynamometer
ECU
Electronic Control Unit
ED
Electro–Deposited Coating
EDU
Electronic Driving Unit
EDIC
Electric Diesel Injection Control
EFI
Electronic Fuel Injection
E/G
Engine
EGR–VM
Egr–Vacuum Modulator
ELR
Emergency Locking Retractor
ENG
Engine
ESA
Electronic Spark Advance
ETCS
Electronic Throttle Control System
EVP
Evaporator
E–VRV
Electric Vacuum Regulating Valve
EXH
Exhaust
FE
Fuel Economy
FF
Front–Engine Front–Wheel–Drive
F/G
Fuel Gage
FIPG
Formed In Place Gasket
FL
Fusible Link
F/P
Fuel Pump
FPU
Fuel Pressure Up
Fr
Front
FR
Front–Engine Rear–Wheel–Drive
F/W
Flywheel
FW/D
Flywheel Damper
FWD
Front–Wheel–Drive
GAS
Gasoline
GND
Ground
HAC
High Altitude Compensator
H/B
Hatchback
H–FUSE
High Current Fuse
HI
High
Author:
Date:
35
IN–36
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
HID
High Intensity Discharge (Head Lamp)
HSG
Housing
HT
Hard Top
HWS
Heated Windshield System
IAC
Idle Air Control
IC
Integrated circuit
IDI
Indirect Diesel Injection
IFS
Independent Front Suspension
IG
Ignition
IIA
Integrated Ignition Assembly
IN
Intake (Manifold, Valve)
INT
Intermittent
I/P
Instrument Panel
IRS
Independent Rear Suspension
J/B
Junction Block
J/C
Junction Connector
KD
Kick–Down
LAN
Local Area Network
LB
Liftback
LCD
Liquid Crystal Display
LED
Light Emitting Diode
LH
Left–Hand
LHD
Left–Hand Drive
L/H/W
Length, Height, Width
LLC
Long–Life Coolant
LNG
Liquified Natural Gas
LO
Low
LPG
Liquified Petroleum Gas
LSD
Limited Slip Differential
LSP & PV
Load Sensing Proportioning And Bypass Valve
LSPV
Load Sensing Proportioning Valve
MAX.
Maximum
MIC
Microphone
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
MIN.
Minimum
MP
Multipurpose
MPX
Multiplex Communication System
M/T
Manual Transmission
MT
Mount
MTG
Mounting
N
Neutral
NA
Natural Aspiration
No.
Number
O/D
Overdrive
OEM
Original Equipment Manufacturing
OHC
Overhead Camshaft
Author:
Date:
36
IN–37
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
OHV
Overhead Valve
OPT
Option
O/S
Oversize
P & BV
Proportioning And Bypass Valve
PCS
Power Control System
PCV
Positive Crankcase Ventilation
PKB
Parking Brake
PPS
Progressive Power Steering
PS
Power Steering
PTO
Power Take–Off
R&P
Rack And Pinion
R/B
Relay Block
RBS
Recirculating Ball Type Steering
R/F
Reinforcement
RFS
Rigid Front Suspension
RRS
Rigid Rear Suspension
RH
Right–Hand
RHD
Right–Hand Drive
RLY
Relay
ROM
Read Only Memory
Rr
Rear
RR
Rear–Engine Rear–Wheel Drive
RWD
Rear–Wheel Drive
SDN
Sedan
SEN
Sensor
SICS
Starting Injection Control System
SOC
State Of Charge
SOHC
Single Overhead Camshaft
SPEC
Specification
SPI
Single Point Injection
SRS
Supplemental Restraint System
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
STD
Standard
STJ
Cold–Start Fuel Injection
SW
Switch
SYS
System
T/A
Transaxle
TACH
Tachometer
TBI
Throttle Body Electronic Fuel Injection
TC
Turbocharger
TCCS
TOYOTA Computer–Controlled System
TCV
Timing Control Valve
TDC
Top Dead Center
TEMP.
Temperature
TEMS
TOYOTA Electronic Modulated Suspension
Author:
Date:
37
IN–38
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
TIS
Total Information System For Vehicle Development
T/M
Transmission
TMC
TOYOTA Motor Corporation
TMMK
TOYOTA Motor Manufacturing Kentucky, Inc.
TRAC
Traction Control System
TURBO
Turbocharge
U/D
Underdrive
U/S
Undersize
VCV
Vacuum Control Valve
VENT
Ventilator
VIN
Vehicle Identification Number
VPS
Variable Power Steering
VSC
Vehicle Skid Control Vehicle Stability Control
VSV
Vacuum Switching Valve
VTV
Vacuum Transmitting Valve
w/
With
WGN
Wagon
W/H
Wire Harness
w/o
Without
1st
First
2nd
Second
2WD
Two Wheel Drive Vehicle (4x2)
4WD
Four Wheel Drive Vehicle (4x4)
Author:
Date:
38
IN–39
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
IN0CI–01
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA TERMS
This glossary lists all SAE–J1930 terms and abbreviations used in this manual in compliance with SAE recommendations, as well as their TOYOTA equivalents.
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
TOYOTA TERMS
( )––ABBREVIATIONS
SAE TERMS
A/C
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner, A/CL
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
AP
Accelerator Pedal
B+
Battery Positive Voltage
+B, Battery Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
HAC
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
CL
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CMP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CPP
Clutch Pedal Position
–
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
–
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
LL ON, Idle ON
DFI
Direct Fuel Injection (Diesel)
Direct Injection (DI)
DI
Distributor Ignition
DLC1
DLC2
DLC3
Data Link Connector 1
Data Link Connector 2
Data Link Connector 3
1: Check Connector
2: Total Diagnosis Comunication Link (TDCL)
3: OBD II Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
–
ECL
Engine Control Level
–
ECM
Engine Control Module
Engine ECU (Electronic Control Unit)
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM),
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
EI
Electronic Ignition
TOYOTA Distributorless Ignition (TDI)
EM
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
EPROM
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
EVAP
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
FC
Fan Control
–
FEEPROM
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable
Read Only Memory
–
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
–
FF
Flexible Fuel
–
FP
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
GEN
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
–
–
–
IN–40
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
HO2S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
IAC
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
IFI
Indirect Fuel Injection
IFS
Inertia Fuel–Shutoff
–
ISC
Idle Speed Control
–
KS
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure
Intake Vacuum
MC
Mixture Control
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
MFI
Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Check Engine Lamp
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
–
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
–
NVRAM
Non–Volatile Random Access Memory
–
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, O2 Sensor (O2S)
OBD
On–Board Diagnostic
On–Board Diagnostic System (OBD)
OC
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalyst Convert (OC), CCo
OP
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
–
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
–
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
–
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
–
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
RAM
Random Access Memory
Random Access Memory (RAM)
RM
Relay Module
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
SC
Supercharger
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger Bypass
E–ABV
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
–
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
–
SRT
System Readiness Test
–
ST
Scan Tool
–
TB
Throttle Body
Throttle Body
TBI
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
TC
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
Torque Converter
–
Indirect Injection (IDL)
–
–
IN–41
INTRODUCTION
–
TERMS
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Transmission ECU, ECT ECU
TP
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TR
Transmission Range
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
TWC
Three–Way Catalytic Converter
Three–Way Catalytic (TWC)
Manifold Converter
CCRO
TWC+OC
Three–Way + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR + CCo
VAF
Volume Air Flow
Air Flow Meter
VR
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU–OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
–
WU–TWC
Warm Up Three–Way Catalytic Converter
–
3GR
Third Gear
–
4GR
Fourth Gear
–
–
FOREWORD
This wiring diagram manual has been prepared to provide
information on the electrical system of the 1999 CAMRY CNG.
Applicable models: SXV 23 Series
For service specifications and repair procedures of the above
models other than those listed in this manual, refer to the
following manuals;
Manual Name
1999 CAMRY Repair Manual
Volume 1
Volume 2
1999 CAMRY CNG Repair Manual
Supplement
1999 CAMRY CNG New Car Features
Pub. No.
RM654U1
RM654U2
RM683U
NCF167U
All information in this manual is based on the latest product
information at the time of publication. However, specifications
and procedures are subject to change without notice.
NOTICE
When handling supplemental restraint system components (removal,
installation or inspection, etc.), always follow the direction given in the repair
manuals listed above to prevent accidents and supplemental restraint
system malfunction.
A INTRODUCTION
This manual consists of the following 13 sections:
No.
Section
Description
INDEX
Index of the contents of this manual.
INTRODUCTION
Brief explanation of each section.
B
HOW TO USE THIS
MANUAL
Instructions on how to use this manual.
C
TROUBLE–
SHOOTING
Describes the basic inspection procedures for electrical circuits.
D
ABBREVIATIONS
Defines the abbreviations used in this manual.
E
GLOSSARY OF
TERMS AND
SYMBOLS
Defines the symbols and functions of major parts.
F
RELAY LOCATIONS
Shows position of the Electronic Control Unit, Relays, Relay Block, etc.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
G
ELECTRICAL
WIRING ROUTING
Describes position of Parts Connectors, Splice points, Ground points, etc.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
INDEX
Index of the system circuits.
SYSTEM CIRCUITS
Electrical circuits of each system are shown from the power supply through ground
points. Wiring connections and their positions are shown and classified by code
according to the connection method. (Refer to the section, ”How to use this manual”).
The ”System Outline” and ”Service Hints” useful for troubleshooting are also contained
in this section.
I
GROUND POINT
Shows ground positions of all parts described in this manual.
J
POWER SOURCE
(Current Flow Chart)
Describes power distribution from the power supply to various electrical loads.
K
CONNECTOR LIST
Describes the form of the connectors for the parts appeared in this book.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
L
PART NUMBER OF
CONNECTORS
Indicates the part number of the connectors used in this manual.
M
OVERALL
ELECTRICAL
WIRING DIAGRAM
Provides circuit diagrams showing the circuit connections.
A
H
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL B
This manual provides information on the electrical circuits installed on vehicles by
dividing them into a circuit for each system.
The actual wiring of each system circuit is shown from the point where the power
source is received from the battery as far as each ground point. (All circuit
diagrams are shown with the switches in the OFF position.)
When troubleshooting any problem, first understand the operation of the circuit
where the problem was detected (see System Circuit section), the power source
supplying power to that circuit (see Power Source section), and the ground points
(see Ground Point section). See the System Outline to understand the circuit
operation.
When the circuit operation is understood, begin troubleshooting of the problem
circuit to isolate the cause. Use Relay Location and Electrical Wiring Routing
sections to find each part, junction block and wiring harness connectors, wiring
harness and wiring harness connectors, splice points, and ground points of each
system circuit. Internal wiring for each junction block is also provided for better
understanding of connection within a junction block.
Wiring related to each system is indicated in each system circuit by arrows
(from__, to__). When overall connections are required, see the Overall Electrical
Wiring Diagram at the end of this manual.
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
∗ The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual
circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
[A]
STOP LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 66)
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
[C]
15A
STOP
7. 5A
GAUGE
4
IB
2
1
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
7 3C
[G]
15 3C
R–L
W–R
R (W/G)
3 IB
L (S/D)
[B]
R–L
4
2
C7
REAR LIGHTS
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
14
[E]
IE1
13
1
G–W
[D]
L (S/D)
I5
[F]
G–W
Y–G
G–W
TO ABS ECU
[H]
7
L4
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
8
DELAY
CIRCUIT
[J]
B18
H17
HIGH MOUNTED
STOP LIGHT
[L]
1
W–B
B18
W–B
1
BV1
W–B
W–B
W–B
3
2
BO
50
[N]
[M]
BL
W–B
4
[K]
(SHIELDED)
R6
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
R7
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–R
G–R
G–R
1
BV1
3
11
G
[I]
4
1
G–R
2
4
B
[I]
[A] : System Title
[B] : Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and
only the Relay Block No. is shown to distinguish it
from the J/B
Example:
Indicates Relay Block No.1
: Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B
= Black
W = White
BR = Brown
L
= Blue
V
SB = Sky Blue
= Violet
R = Red
G = Green
LG = Light Green
[C] : (
) is used to indicate different wiring and
connector, etc. when the vehicle model, engine
type, or specification is different.
P
Y
GR = Gray
[D] : Indicates related system.
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the
second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
[E] : Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness
connector. The wiring harness with male terminal is
shown with arrows (
).
Outside numerals are pin numbers.
= Pink
= Yellow
O = Orange
Example:
L–Y
L
(Blue)
Female
Male (
)
Y
(Yellow)
[J] : Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are ”E” for the
Engine Room, ”I” for the Instrument Panel, and ”B”
for the Body).
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness
and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component’s location, e.g, ”E” for the Engine
Compartment, ”I” for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and ”B” for the Body and
Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second
letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g, IH1,
IH2), this indicates the same type of wiring harness
and wiring harness connector.
[F] : Represents a part (all parts are shown in sky blue).
The code is the same as the code used in parts
position.
[G] : Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B
No. and the connector code is shown beside it).
Junction Blocks are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts.
Example:
,,,,
,,,,
3C indicates
,,,,
that it is inside
,,,,
Junction Block
,,,,
No.3
,,,,
,,,,
The Location of splice Point I 5 is indicated by the
shaded section.
[K] : Indicates a shielded cable.
[L] : Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and
male connectors.
Example: Numbered in order
from upper left to
lower right
Female
Numbered in order
from upper right to
lower left
Male
[M] : Indicates a ground point.
[H] : When 2 parts both use one connector in common,
the parts connector name used in the wire routing
section is shown in square brackets [
].
The first letter of the code for each ground point(s)
indicates the component’s location, e.g, ”E” for the
Engine Compartment, ”I” for the Instrument Panel
and Surrounding area, and ”B” for the Body and
Surrounding area.
[N] : Page No.
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
[O]
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current is applied at all times through the STOP fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the stop light SW.
When the ignition SW is turned on, current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor, and also flows
through the rear lights warning light to TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor.
STOP LIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
When the ignition SW is turned on and the brake pedal is pressed (Stop light SW on), if the stop light circuit is open, the current
flowing from TERMINAL 7 of the light failure sensor to TERMINALS 1, 2 changes, so the light failure sensor detects the
disconnection and the warning circuit of the light failure sensor is activated.
As a result, the current flows from TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 11 to GROUND and turns the rear lights
warning light on. By pressing the brake pedal, the current flowing to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor keeps the warning
circuit on and holds the warning light on until the ignition SW is turned off.
[P]
SERVICE HINTS
S6 STOP LIGHT SW
2–1 : Closed with the brake pedal depressed
L4 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
1, 2, 7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the stop light SW on
4, 8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
11–GROUND : Always continuity
[Q]
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
See Page
Code
See Page
34
L4
36
R7
37
H17
36
R6
37
S6
35
: RELAY BLOCKS
[R]
Code
1
[S]
Code
C7
@@@
ÀÀÀ
,,,
,,,
@@@
ÀÀÀ
,,,
@@@
ÀÀÀ
Code
See Page
18
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
R/B No.1 (Instrument Panel Left)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IB
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
3C
22
Instrument Panel Wire and J/B No.3 (Instrument Panel Left Side)
[T]
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
42
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
BV1
50
Luggage Room Wire and Floor Wire (Luggage Compartment Left)
[U]
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
BL
50
Under the Left Quarter Pillar
BO
50
Back Panel Center
[V]
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I5
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
B18
See Page
50
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Luggage Room Wire
B
[O] : Explains the system outline.
[P] : Indicates values or explains the function for reference during troubleshooting.
[Q] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of the parts in the system circuit.
Example : Part ”L4” (Light Failure Sensor) is on page 36 of the manual.
∗ The letter in the code is from the first letter of the part, and the number indicates its order in parts
starting with that letter.
Example : L 4
Á
Á
Parts is 4th in order
Light Failure Sensor
[R] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of Relay Block Connectors in the system circuit.
Example : Connector ”1” is described on page 18 of this manual and is installed on the left side of the instrument
panel.
[S] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of J/B and Wire Harness in the system circuit.
Example : Connector ”3C” connects the Instrument Panel Wire and J/B No.3. It is described on page 22 of this
manual, and is installed on the instrument panel left side.
[T] : Indicates the reference page describing the wiring harness and wiring harness connector (the female wiring
harness is shown first, followed by the male wiring harness).
Example : Connector ”IE1” connects the floor wire (female) and Instrument panel wire (male). It is described on
page 42 of this manual, and is installed on the left side kick panel.
[U] : Indicates the reference page showing the position of the ground points on the vehicle.
Example : Ground point ”BO” is described on page 50 of this manual and is installed on the back panel center.
[V] : Indicates the reference page showing the position of the splice points on the vehicle.
Example : Splice point ”I5” is on the Cowl Wire Harness and is described on page 44 of this manual.
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The ground points circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective ground points. When
troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use a common ground may help you identify
the problem ground quickly. The relationship between ground points ( EA , IB and IC shown below) can also be
checked this way.
I GROUND POINT
FAN MAIN RELAY
5
A/C FAN RELAY NO.2
5
A/C FAN RELAY NO.3
5
E3
O/D MAIN SW
E3
CLOCK
W–B
W–B
A
A
A
A
E5
E6
W–B
FRONT SIDE MARKER
LIGHT RH
W–B
FRONT SIDE MARKER
LIGHT LH
W–B
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
WARNING SW
W–B
W–B
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
W–B
I4
W–B
2
IA1
B4
COMBINATION METER
W–B
1
3D
W–B
CRUISE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
3
3F
W–B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
13
3G
W–B
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
5 W–B
3E
I2
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
6
3E
I2
LIGHT CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
WIPER AND WASHER
SW [COMB. SW]
W–B
I5
15
ID1
W–B
W–B
I5
W–B
W–B
BLOWER RESISTOR
8
IB1
W–B
I8
W–B
A/C AMPLIFIER
4
4
POWER WINDOW
CONTROL RELAY
B5
DOOR KEY LOCK SW LH
B5
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW
FUEL CONTROL SW
3
IC3
I5
W–B
WOOFER AMPLIFIER
BR
COMBINATION METER
4
BR
BR
4
I3
BR
I3
COMBINATION METER
BR
FUEL SENDER
W–B
4
BR
BR
5
BA1
W–B
AUTO ANTENNA
MOTOR
B5
(4A–GZE)
W–B
HEATER RELAY
POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW
I5
4
W–B
BR
B5
DOOR LOCK MOTOR LH
W–B
4
RADIO AND PLAYER
UNLOCK WARNING
SW
W–B
W–B
HORN SW [COMB. SW]
DIMMER SW
[COMB. SW]
I2
W–B
10 EA2
I4
BLOWER SW
I5
W–B
B4
W–B
I6
W–B
EA
ELECTRICAL IDLE−UP
CUT RELAY (M/T)
HEATER SERVO
MOTOR AMPLIFIER
PARKING BRAKE SW
7 W–B
3C
E4
B4
I6
W–B
7
3B
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
RH
A
E5
E4
W–B HEATER CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
W–B
E4
W–B
DOOR KEY LOCK
SW RH
A
E2
E4
W–B
W–B
E3
W–B
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
RELAY
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
E3
W–B
RETRACT MOTOR LH
PARKING LIGHT LH
W–B
W–B
RETRACT MOTOR RH
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
W–B
W–B
RETRACT CONTROL
RELAY
PARKING LIGHT RH
W–B
W–B
RADIATOR FAN MOTOR
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
W–B
W–B
5
W–B
FAN MAIN RELAY
IB
∗
IC
The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
B
The ”Current Flow Chart” section, describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit breakers)
transmits current to. In the Power Source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery power is supplied to each system
are explained. Since all System Circuit diagrams start from the power source, the power source system must be fully
understood.
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
The chart below shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each electrical source
(Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
10A ECU–B
Short Pin
2
2
7.5A DOME
15A EFI
Battery
30A AM2
Fusible Link Block
2
10A HAZARD
6
2
20A RADIO NO.1
Starter
S2
10A HORN
100A ALT
60A ABS
6
5
Engine Room R/B (See Page 20)
Fuse
20A
10A
System
Page
STOP
ABS
ABS and Traction Control
Cruise Control
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
Multiplex Communication System
194
187
180
166
210
DOME
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
Combination Meter
Headlight
Interior Light
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning
Light Auto Turn Off
Theft Deterrent and Door Lock Control
214
230
112
122
POWER SOURCE
40A DOOR LOCK CB
1.25B FL MAIN
W
W
W
2
2
7
EB1
W
W
B
W
B
1
7.5A DOME
I2
50A MAIN
E7
2
W–L
W
W
W
I2
1
1
R
W
I2
1
B
W
1
W
B
2
2
4
W–B
2
B
4
B
B
2
3
2
4
1
2
1
W–B
2
2
3
B–W
1
3
2
G
15A TAIL
1
20A DEFOG
B–Y
1
G
W–R
1
B
2
1
4
I8
IGNITION SW
B–W
STARTER RELAY
E7
8
IG1
3
ACC
2
1
IG2
B
2
1
TAIL
RELAY
INJECTION RELAY
B–O
E7
2
W
15A HAZ–RADIO
AM1
2
6
EB1
W–R
W–R
2
AM2
E7
7.5A AM2
B
G–W
W
BATTERY
3 EA2 1 EA1
W–B
1
1
E6
15A RAD CIG
B–Y
1
∗
P–L
1
The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
K CONNECTOR LIST
[A]
I14
I15
DARK GRAY
GRAY
1
1
2
I16
J1
J2
BLACK
2
A
A
1 2
A
A
A
A B B
D D
A A B CC CD D
A
6 7 8
[B]
J3
J4
K1
K2
L1
1 2
1 2
DARK GRAY
A
A A
A A A A A
A B B
DD
A A B CC CDD
L2
L3
L4
M1
M2
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 101112
1
2
3 45 6 78
M3
1
2
1
1 2
3 4
2
M4
[D]
N1
GRAY
1 2 3
[C]
BLACK
GRAY
1
1
1
7
5
6
2 3 4
8 9 10
N2
O1
O2
GRAY
BLACK
DARK GRAY
1
1
1
2
[A] : Indicates connector to be connected to a part. (The numeral indicates the pin No.)
[B] : Junction Connector
Indicates a connector which is connected to a short terminal.
Junction Connector
Junction connector in this manual include a short terminal which is
connected to a number of wire harnesses. Always perform
inspection with the short terminal installed. (When installing the
wire harnesses, the harnesses can be connected to any position
within the short terminal grouping. Accordingly, in other vehicles,
the same position in the short terminal may be connected to a wire
harness from a different part.)
Wire harness sharing the same short terminal grouping have the
same color.
Same Color
Short Terminal
[C] : Parts Code
The first letter of the code is taken from the first letter of part, and the numbers indicates its order in parts which
start with the same letter.
[D] : Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
B
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Code
A1
Part Name
A/C Ambient Temp. Sensor
Part Name
Part Number
Part Number
Code
90980–11070
D4
Diode (Door Courtesy Light)
90980–11608
90980–10962
A2
A/C Condenser Fan Motor
90980–11237
D5
Diode (Key Off Operation)
A3
A/C Condenser Fan Relay
90980–10940
D6
Diode (Luggage Compartment Light)
90980–11608
D7
Door Lock Control Relay
90980–10848
ÁÁ
ÁÁ
A4
[A]
A5
A/C Triple Pressure SW (A/C Dual and
Single Pressure SW)
A/T Oil Temp. Sensor
[B]
ÁÁ
ÁÁ
90980–10943
D8
Door Courtesy Light LH
[C]
90980–11413
D9
Door Courtesy Light RH
90980–11148
A6
ABS Actuator
90980–11151
D10
Door Courtesy SW LH
A7
ABS Actuator
90980–11009
D11
Door Courtesy SW RH
A8
ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
90980–10941
D12
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
A9
ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
90980–11002
D13
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
A10
Airbag Sensor Front LH
D14
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
A11
Airbag Sensor Front RH
A12
Auto Antenna Motor
90980–11097
90980–11856
D15
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
90980–11194
D16
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW LH
90980–11194
D17
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW RH
90980–11156
90980–11170
[A] : Part Code
[B] : Part Name
[C] : Part Number
Toyota Part Number are indicated.
Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply. In case of ordering a connector
or terminal with wire, please confirm in advance if there is supply for it using “Parts Catalog News” (published by
Parts Engineering Administration Dept.).
C TROUBLESHOOTING
To Ignition SW
IG Terminal
Fuse
[A]
SW 1
Voltmeter
[B]
VOLTAGE CHECK
(a) Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check
point.
Example:
[A] – Ignition SW on
[B] – Ignition SW and SW 1 on
[C] – Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (SW 2 off)
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground
point or negative battery terminal, and the positive lead to the
connector or component terminal.
This check can be done with a test light instead of a voltmeter.
Relay
[C]
Solenoid
SW 2
CONTINUITY AND RESISTANCE CHECK
(a) Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage
between the check points.
(b) Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check
points.
Ohmmeter
SW
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check
again.
When contacting the negative lead to the diode positive side
and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be
continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no
continuity.
Ohmmeter
Diode
(c) Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V
minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical circuit.
Digital Type
Analog Type
C
To Ignition SW
IG Terminal
Test Light
Fuse Case
Short [A]
SW 1
Short [B]
Disconnect
Disconnect
Light
(a) Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse.
(b) Connect a test light in place of the fuse.
(c) Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example:
[A] – Ignition SW on
[B] – Ignition SW and SW 1 on
[C] – Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (Connect the
Relay) and SW 2 off (or Disconnect SW 2)
(d) Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the
test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light
stays lit and the connector where the light goes out.
(e) Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the
problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
Relay
Short [C]
Disconnect
SW 2
FINDING A SHORT CIRCUIT
(a) Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless
absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals are touched,
the IC may be destroyed by static electricity.)
(b) When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of
the digital meter, be careful that no part of your body or
clothing comes in contact with the terminals of leads
from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Solenoid
DISCONNECTION OF MALE AND FEMALE
CONNECTORS
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not
the wire harness.
HINT : Check to see what kind of connector you are
disconnecting before pulling apart.
Pull Up
Press Down
Pull Up
Press Down
C TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO REPLACE TERMINAL
(with terminal retainer or secondary locking device)
Reference:
1. PREPARE THE SPECIAL TOOL
10
3
1
HINT : To remove the terminal from the connector, please
construct and use the special tool or like object shown on
the left.
2. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
1
Example:
(Case 1)
0.2
(mm)
Up
Tool
3. DISENGAGE THE SECONDARY LOCKING DEVICE OR
TERMINAL RETAINER.
(a) Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal
locking clip can be released and the terminal removed from
the connector.
(b) Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary
locking device or terminal retainer.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Terminal Retainer
[A]
Terminal Retainer
For Non–Waterproof Type Connector
HINT : The needle insertion position varies according to the
connector’s shape (number of terminals etc.), so
check the position before inserting it.
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Stopper
”Case 1”
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock
position.
Terminal
Retainer
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
Example:
(Case 2)
Secondary
Locking Device
”Case 2”
Open the secondary locking device.
C
Tool
Tab
Tab
Example:
(Case 1)
[B]
Terminal
Retainer
Tool
[Male]
Access Hole
(
Mark)
Tool
For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT : Terminal retainer color is different
according to connector body.
Example:
Terminal Retainer
Black or White
Black or White
Gray or White
: Connector Body
: Gray
: Dark Gray
: Black
[Female]
”Case 1”
Type where terminal retainer is pulled
up to the temporary lock position (Pull
Type).
Insert the special tool into the terminal
retainer access hole (Mark) and pull
the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT : The needle insertion position varies
according to the connector’s shape
(Number of terminals etc.), so check
the position before inserting it.
Retainer
at Full Lock Position
Retainer
at Temporary Lock Position
[Male]
Example:
(Case 2)
[Female]
”Case 2”
Type which cannot be pulled as far as
Power Lock insert the tool straight into
the access hole of terminal retainer as
shown.
Terminal Retainer
Tool
Tool
[Male]
Press Down
Press Down
[Female]
C TROUBLESHOOTING
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Retainer at
Full Lock Position
Retainer at
Temporary Lock Position
[Male]
[Female]
(c) Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out
from rear.
Locking Lug
Tool
4. INSTALL TERMINAL TO CONNECTOR
(a) Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug locks firmly.
3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock
position.
(b) Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to
the full lock position.
5. CONNECT CONNECTOR
ABBREVIATIONS D
ABBREVIATIONS
The following abbreviations are used in this manual.
ABS
=
Anti–Lock Brake System
A/C
=
Air Conditioning
A/T
=
Automatic Transaxle
COMB. =
Combination
ECU
=
Electronic Control Unit
EGR
=
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ESA
=
Electronic Spark Advance
EVAP
=
Evaporative Emission
FL
=
Fusible Link
IAC
=
Idle Air Control
J/B
=
Junction Block
LH
=
Left–Hand
O/D
=
Overdrive
R/B
=
Relay Block
RH
=
Right–Hand
SFI
=
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
SRS
=
Supplemental Restraint System
SW
=
Switch
TEMP.
=
Temperature
VSV
=
Vacuum Switching Valve
w/
=
With
w/o
=
Without
∗ The titles given inside the components are the names of the terminals (terminal codes) and are not treated as being
abbreviations.
E GLOSSARY OF TERMS AND SYMBOLS
GROUND
The point at which wiring attaches to
the Body, thereby providing a return
path for an electrical circuit; without a
ground, current cannot flow.
BATTERY
Stores chemical energy and
converts it into electrical energy.
Provides DC current for the auto’s
various electrical circuits.
CAPACITOR (Condenser)
A small holding unit for temporary
storage of electrical voltage.
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
An electric resistance heating
element.
HEADLIGHTS
Current flow causes a headlight
1. SINGLE
filament to heat up and emit light. A
FILAMENT
headlight may have either a single
(1) filament or a double (2) filament
2. DOUBLE
FILAMENT
CIRCUIT BREAKER
Basically a reusable fuse, a circuit
breaker will heat and open if too
much current flows through it.
Some units automatically reset when
cool, others must be manually reset.
HORN
An electric device which sounds a
loud audible signal.
DIODE
A semiconductor which allows
current flow in only one direction.
IGNITION COIL
Converts low–voltage DC current
into high–voltage ignition current for
firing the spark plugs.
DIODE, ZENER
LIGHT
Current flow through a filament
causes the filament to heat up and
emit light.
A diode which allows current flow in one
direction but blocks reverse flow only up
to a specific voltage. Above that potential,
it passes the excess voltage. This acts as
a simple voltage regulator.
PHOTODIODE
The photodiode is a semiconductor
which controls the current flow
according to the amount of light.
LED (LIGHT EMITTING DIODE)
Upon current flow, these diodes emit
light without producing the heat of a
comparable light.
DISTRIBUTOR, IIA
Channels high–voltage current from
the ignition coil to the individual
spark plugs.
METER, ANALOG
Current flow activates a magnetic
coil which causes a needle to move,
thereby providing a relative display
against a background calibration.
FUSE
METER, DIGITAL
Current flow activates one or many
LED’s, LCD’s, or fluorescent
displays, which provide a relative or
digital display.
A thin metal strip which burns through
when too much current flows through it,
thereby stopping current flow and
protecting a circuit from damage.
FUEL
FUSIBLE LINK
(for Medium Current Fuse)
(for High Current Fuse or
Fusible Link)
A heavy–gauge wire placed in high
amperage circuits which burns through on
overloads, thereby protecting the circuit.
The numbers indicate the crosssection
surface area of the wires.
M
MOTOR
A power unit which converts
electrical energy into mechanical
energy, especially rotary motion.
E
RELAY
Basically, an electrically operated
1. NORMALLY switch which may be normally
CLOSED closed (1) or open (2).
Current flow through a small coil
creates a magnetic field which either
opens or closes an attached switch.
SPEAKER
An electromechanical device which
creates sound waves from current
flow.
2. NORMALLY
OPEN
SWITCH, MANUAL
1. NORMALLY
OPEN
RELAY, DOUBLE THROW
A relay which passes current
through one set of contacts or the
other.
Opens and closes
circuits,
i it thereby
th b
stopping (1) or
allowing (2) current
flow.
2. NORMALLY
CLOSED
RESISTOR
An electrical component with a fixed
resistance, placed in a circuit to
reduce voltage to a specific value.
SWITCH, DOUBLE THROW
A switch which continuously passes
current through one set of contacts
or the other.
RESISTOR, TAPPED
A resistor which supplies two or
more different non adjustable
resistance values.
SWITCH, IGNITION
A key operated switch with several
positions which allows various
circuits, particularly the primary
ignition circuit, to become
operational.
RESISTOR, VARIABLE or RHEOSTAT
A controllable resistor with a variable
rate of resistance.
Also called a potentiometer or
rheostat.
SENSOR (Thermistor)
A resistor which varies its resistance
with temperature.
SWITCH, WIPER PARK
Automatically returns wipers to the
stop position when the wiper switch
is turned off.
SENSOR, SPEED
Uses magnetic impulses to open
and close a switch to create a signal
for activation of other components.
TRANSISTOR
A solidstate device typically used as
an electronic relay; stops or passes
current depending on the voltage
applied at ”base”.
(Reed Switch Type)
SHORT PIN
Used to provide an unbroken
connection within a junction block.
SOLENOID
An electromagnetic coil which forms
a magnetic field when current flows,
to move a plunger, etc.
WIRES
Wires are always drawn as
(1) NOT
straight lines on wiring
CONNECTED diagrams.
Crossed wires (1) without a
black dot at the junction
are
j
nott joined;
j i d
crossed wires (2) with a
black dot or octagonal ( )
(2) SPLICED
mark at the junction are
spliced (joined)
connections.
F RELAY LOCATIONS
[Engine Compartment]
[Instrument Panel]
F
[Body]
F RELAY LOCATIONS
,,,
,,,
,,,: Instrument Panel J/B
Lower Finish Panel (See Page 20)
F
[Instrument Panel J/B Inner Circuit]
F RELAY LOCATIONS
,,,
,,,
,,,: Engine Room J/B No.2 Engine Compartment Left (See Page 20)
F
[Engine Room J/B No.2 Inner Circuit]
F RELAY LOCATIONS
1
Engine Compartment Left (See Page 20)
: Engine Room R/B No.1 (Inside Engine Room J/B No.2)
3
: Engine Room R/B No.3 Radiator Upper Support RH (See Page 20)
F
Fusible Link Block
Engine Compartment Left (See Page 20)
(Inside Engine Room J/B No.2)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
A 1 A/C Condenser Fan Motor
A 2 A/C Magnetic Clutch and Lock Sensor
A 3 A/C Triple Pressure SW
(A/C Dual and Single Pressure SW)
A 4 ABS Actuator
A 5 ABS Actuator
A 6 ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
A 7 ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
A 8 Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
A 9 Airbag Sensor Front LH
A 10 Airbag Sensor Front RH
B 1 Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
C 1 Camshaft Position Sensor
C 2 Crankshaft Position Sensor
C 3 Cruise Control Actuator
D 1 Data Link Connector 1
E 1 Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
E 2 Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
E 3 Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
F 1
F 2
F 3
F 4
F 5
F 6
F 7
F 8
F 9
F 10
F 11
F 12
F 13
F 14
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light LH
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light RH
Front Wiper Motor
Fuel Pressure Sensor (Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (Fuel Pipe)
Fuel Shutoff Valve (Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Shutoff Valve (Fuel Pressure Regulator)
Fuel Temp. Sensor (Delivery Pipe)
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
G 1 Generator
G 2 Generator
H
H
H
H
1
2
3
4
Headlight LH
Headlight RH
Horn (High)
Horn (Low)
G
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Idle Air Control Valve
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.1
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.2
Injector No.1
Injector No.2
Injector No.3
Injector No.4
Intake Air Temp. Sensor
R 1 Radiator Fan Motor
S 1 Starter
S 2 Starter
T 1 Throttle Position Sensor
V 1 Vehicle Speed Sensor (Combination Meter)
V 2 VSV (EGR)
M 1 Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
N 1 Noise Filter (Ignition)
O 1 Oil Pressure SW
P 1 Park/Neutral Position SW,A/T Indicator Light SW and
Back–Up Light SW
P 2 Power Steering Oil Pressure SW
W
W
W
W
1
2
3
4
Washer Level Warning SW
Washer Motor
Water Temp. Sender
Water Temp. SW No.1
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
A 11
A 12
A 13
A 14
A 15
A 16
A 17
A 18
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
A/C SW
ABS ECU
ABS ECU
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
Airbag Squib (Front Passenger Airbag Assembly)
Airbag Squib (Steering Wheel Pad)
Ashtray Illumination
B 2 Blower Motor
B 3 Blower Resistor
B 4 Blower SW
C 4
C 5
C 6
C 7
C 8
C 9
C10
C 11
C12
C13
C14
C15
C16
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Cigarette Lighter
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
Clock
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Combination SW
Combination SW
Combination SW
Cruise Control ECU
D
D
D
D
D
2
3
4
5
6
Data Link Connector 2
Data Link Connector 3
Diode (Courtesy)
Diode (Dome)
Diode (Idle–Up)
E
E
E
E
4
5
6
7
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
G 3 Glove Box Light and SW
H 5 Hazard SW
H 6 Heated Oxygen Sensor
H 7 Heater Control SW
I 9 Ignition Key Cylinder Light
I 10 Ignition SW
I 11 Integration Relay
I 12 Integration Relay
G
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
J 1
J 2
J 3
J 4
J 5
J 6
J 7
J 8
J 9
J 10
J 11
J 12
J 13
J 14
J 15
J 16
J 17
J 18
J 19
J 20
J 21
J 22
J 23
J 24
J 25
J 26
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
J 27
J 28
J 29
J 30
J 31
J 32
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
K 1 Key Interlock Solenoid
O 2 O/D Main SW and A/T Shift Lever Illumination
P 3 Parking Brake SW
P 4 Power Outlet
R
R
R
R
R
2
3
4
5
6
Radio and Player
Radio and Player
Rear Window Defogger SW
Remote Control Mirror SW
Rheostat
S 3 Shift Lock ECU
S 4 Stop Light SW
T 2 Turn Signal Flasher
U 1 Unlock Warning SW
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Body
A 19 ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
A 20 ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
F 15 Front Door Speaker LH
F 16 Front Door Speaker RH
F 17 Fuel Temp. Sensor and Fuel Shutoff Valve (Fuel Tank)
B 5 Buckle SW LH
H 8 High Mounted Stop Light
C17 Condenser
I 13 Interior Light
D 7
D 8
D 9
D10
D 11
D12
D13
D14
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front RH
Door Lock Control SW RH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW
Front LH
D15 Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW
Front RH
D16 Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW
Rear LH
D17 Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW
Rear RH
J 33 Junction Connector
J 34 Junction Connector
J 35 Junction Connector
L
L
L
L
L
1
2
3
4
5
License Plate Light LH
License Plate Light RH
Light Failure Sensor
Luggage Compartment Light
Luggage Compartment Light SW
G
Position of Parts in Body
N 2 Noise Filter (Rear Window Defogger)
P
P
P
P
5
6
7
8
P 9
P 10
P 11
P 12
P 13
P 14
Power Window Control SW Front RH
Power Window Control SW Rear LH
Power Window Control SW Rear RH
Power Window Master SW and
Door Lock Control SW LH
Power Window Motor Front LH
Power Window Motor Front RH
Power Window Motor Rear LH
Power Window Motor Rear RH
Pretensioner LH
Pretensioner RH
R 7
R 8
R 9
R10
R 11
R12
R13
R14
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Speaker LH
Rear Speaker RH
Remote Control Mirror LH
Remote Control Mirror RH
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
: Location of Splice Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EA1
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room Main No.3 Wire (Radiator LH)
EB1
EB2
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
No 2)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IA1
Cowl Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IB1
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IC1
IC2
ID1
ID2
IE1
IE2
IF1
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Splice Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IG1
IG2
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
IG3
IH1
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
II1
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Cowl Side Panel RH)
IJ1
IJ2
IK1
IL1
IL2
IM1
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
Floor No.2 Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
: Location of Splice Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
BA1
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BB1
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
POWER SOURCE
G2
GENERATOR
B
1
60A FL ABS
B–G
1
3
2
B–R
W–B
1
4
L–B
1
1
B–R
2
3
5
L–R
1
1
1
HTR RELAY
1
E3
1 C
1 D
2
3
5
1
2
30A CDS
4
2F
W–B
5
2C
W–B
6
2K
20A EFI
10A HAZARD
20A RADIO NO. 1
10A HORN
B–R
4
2L
B–G
30A AM2
SHORT PIN
B–R
10A ECU–B
2
FL MAIN 3. 0W
W–B
1
W–R
B
1
2A
B
3
2B
5A ALT–S
7. 5A DOME
40A MAIN
HEAD RELAY
2
1
2
4
3
3
2G
R–B
1
4
2G
BATTERY
15A HEAD (RH)
15A HEAD (LH)
EB
W–B
1 A
50A
HTR
1
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
1 E
F 9 A , F10 B , F11 C ,
L–B
2 F
4
2
2B
F12 D , F13 E , F14 F
B–R
1 F
100A
ALT
2
30A RDI
B–R
1 B
L–R
1
10A A/C
L–B
1
2
W–B
B–G
L–W
1
B–R
4
1B
5
3
1
2
10A TAIL
25A DOOR
7. 5A PANEL
15A STOP
TAILLIGHT RELAY
7. 5A OBD
30A POWER
1
POWER RELAY
5
3
2
1
2
NOISE FILTER
1
2
B–R
NOISE FILTER
1
2
I2
40A DEF
1
2
7
1J
W–B
DEFOGGER RELAY
5
3
10A MIRROR–HEATER
B–R
1
1B
W
2
1K
1
1
2
2
40A AM1
15A CIG
7. 5A RAD–NO. 2
2 AM1
ACC 3
L–R
IG1 4
B–Y
6
1K
1
1K
15A POWER–OUTLET
15A ECU–IG
10A HEATER
10A GAUGE
IG2 6
B–R
ST2 8
R
25A WIPER
7. 5A TURN
I10
IGNITION SW
W–R
W–R
B–R
3
1K
4
1K
5
1K
5
1B
6
1A
5A IGN
5A STARTER
W–B
7 AM2
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
POWER SOURCE
SERVICE HINTS
HEAD RELAY
2–1 : Closed with the light control SW at HEAD position or the dimmer SW at FLASH position
TAILLIGHT RELAY
5–3 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
I10 IGNITION SW
2–3 : Closed with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
2–4 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
7–6 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
7–8 : Closed with the ignition SW at ST position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
F9
A
28
F12
D
28
G2
28
F10
B
28
F13
E
28
I10
30
F11
C
28
F14
F
28
J9
31
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
See Page
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
1
26
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
3
26
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Radiator Upper Support RH)
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1A
1B
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1K
2A
2B
2C
2F
2G
2K
2L
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
34
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
I2
See Page
38
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
MEMO
STARTING AND IGNITION
W–R
7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
ST2 8
R
I10
IGNITION SW
3
1K
8
1C
12
IG3
B–R
B–R
4 1K
5A
STARTER
5 1K
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
B–W
B–W
B
3 1J
W–R
B–W
5 1B
B–W
11 IG2
B–W
4 2L
2
5
30A
AM2
40A
MAIN
1
ST
RELAY
5
P
1 2A
1
3
2
3 2B
5 2D
9 2K
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
N
11 2J
6
GR
B
B
10 IG2
GR
F 9 A , F11 C
W–B
B–R
1 C
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
B–G
GR
1 A
C B
J6 A ,
J7 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B A
B A
FL MAIN
3. 0W
1 B
1
A
W–B
B–R
M
BATTERY
S1 A , S2 B
STARTER
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
IF
GR
GR
J19
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
C
C
B–R
C
B–R
C
B–R
B–R
1
1
1
+B
GND
IGF
2
3
4
3
2
W–R
BR
W–R
Y–R
IGT
I3
IGNITION COIL
AND IGNITER
NO. 2
IGT
B
I2
IGNITION COIL
AND IGNITER
NO. 1
IGF
A
B–W
A
W–R
20 C
3 C
IGT1
IGF
BR
W–R
NSW
4
A
I4
6 A
GND
BR
+B
N1
NOISE FILTER
(IGNITION)
B–W
19 C
IGT2
STA
11 A
E4 A , E6 C
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
BR
GR
EC
J18
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
STARTING AND IGNITION
SERVICE HINTS
I10 IGNITION SW
7–6 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
7–8 : Closed with the ignition SW at ST position
P1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
5–6 : Closed with the A/T shift lever in P or N position
S1 (A), S2 (B) STARTER
Points closed with the Park/Neutral position SW at P or N position and the ignition SW at ST position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
I10
Code
See Page
E4
A
30
30
J22
31
E6
C
30
J6
F9
A
28
J7
A
31
N1
29
B
31
P1
F11
C
28
J9
31
S1
A
29
I2
29
J18
31
S2
B
29
I3
29
J19
31
29
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
1C
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
24
Cowl Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
1K
2A
2B
2D
2J
2K
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IG2
IG3
See Page
38
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EC
34
Intake Manifold
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I4
See Page
38
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
MEMO
CHARGING
B–G
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
B–Y
7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
W
W–R
ST2
2 1K
5 1K
3 1K
I10
IGNITION SW
1 1K
5A
IGN
10A
GAUGE
2
40A
AM1
2 1J
B–R
8 1T
C10 A , C11 B
3 2C
B–R
4 2L
4 B
5A
ALT–S
Y
30A
AM2
13 A
R–L
5 1B
W–R
1 1B
CHARGE WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
1
4
E3
IE2
B–R
B
1 F
2 F
1 C
Y
B–R
1 B
W
B–G
1 2A
6 EB1
4
R–L
Y
B–G
1 A
IJ2
B–G
100A
ALT
F 9 A , F10 B ,
F11 C , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
G1 B , G2 A
3 A 1 A 2 A
S
L
IG
FL MAIN
3. 0W
BATTERY
IC REGULATOR
1 B
B
GENERATOR
SERVICE HINTS
G1 (B), G2 (A) GENERATOR
(A)3–GROUND : 13.5–14.3 volts with the engine running at 5000 rpm and 115C (239F)
(B)1–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C10
A
30
C11
B
F9
A
Code
See Page
Code
F10
B
28
G1
30
F11
C
28
G2
28
F14
F
28
See Page
28
A
28
I10
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
B
30
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1K
1T
2A
2C
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EB1
34
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
IE2
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
IJ2
38
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
34
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
ENGINE CONTROL
R
FROM POWER SOURCE
SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
B–R
20A
EFI
IG2 6
B–R
7 AM2
R
B–R
8
2J
7 2K
W–R
ST2 8
I10
IGNITION SW
B–R
1
5
EFI
RELAY
B–R
B–R
W–R
3
5 2C
4 2F
10 2C
1
1
5 1B
2
B–R
1
W–B
7 1W
W–B
5 1K
3 1K
B–Y
2
2J
B–Y
5
5A
IGN
CIR OPN
RELAY
4 2L
2
30A
AM2
8 1C
3
1
1
L–B
L–B
1 2A
G–R
B–R
L–B
B
LG–B
1 C
4 EB1
2 IG1
LG–B
L–B
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
5 EB1
G–R
F 9 A , F11 C
1
3
2
4
F17
FUEL TEMP. SENSOR AND
SHUTOFF VALVE
(FUEL TANK)
LG–B
IB1
BR
G–R
B–R
W–B
B–R
W–B
BATTERY
4
L–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
IB1
W–B
7
W–B
B–G
1 A
BR
A
BK
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
EB
R
B–Y
4 1K
5A STARTER
L–B
B–W
B–Y
9 IG3
5
11 IG2
B–W
3 1J
P
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
N
B–Y
B–Y
E3
6
B
B–Y
B
B–Y
E A
E A
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–W
10 IG2
B
B A
GR
B–Y
GR
B–Y
C B
B A
J6 A ,
J23 A , J24 B
J7 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–Y
B–W
B A
B B
GR
L–B
B–Y
W–B
LG–B
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C , E7 D
12 A
THCNG1
+B
BATT
11 A
NSW
20 C
3 C
19 C
Y–R
IGT2
22 A
W–R
IGF
14 A
B
IGT1
STA
B–R
+B1
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
6 A
G–R
FC
1 A
E05
26 C
BR
1 D
3
IGT
IGF
+B
GND
4
W–R
2
IGF
IGT
+B
GND
1
4
B–R
B–R
12
IG3
C
B–R
C
BR
B–R
G–R
B–R
BR
1
3
I3
IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER NO. 2
2
I2
IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER NO. 1
W–R
I4
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
A
BR
A
A
A
BR
J18
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–Y
BR
W–B
BR
BR
EC
Y
BR
2
IB1
I4
VOUT
2
3
BR
VC
GND
1
I4
I5
BR
Y
1 B
BR
3
IG2
1
VC
VCNG3
2 A
HTAF
11 B
VTA
9 B
BR
3
VTA
E2
I4
Y
I4
2
E2
BR
1
E2
3
VC
2
AF–
2 B
PIM
3 B
THA
2
1
I4
BR
2
1
P–B
4 D
14 B
6 B
4 B
THW
BR
23 C
L
HT
F8
FUEL TEMP. SENSOR
(DELIVERY PIPE)
1
G–B
4
BR
+B
BR
10 C
B–W
2
A8
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
G
1
(SHIELDED)
G
2
E3
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
VC
Y–B
EGR
B
B–Y
J18
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
P
B–Y
B
I8
INTAKE AIR TEMP. SENSOR
B–Y
7 D
BR
5 D
F6
FUEL SHUTOFF VALVE
(DELIVERY PIPE)
1
LG
P–B
V2
VSV (EGR)
B–Y
L–B
B–Y
1
VC
2
Y
PCNG1
Y
PCNG2
B
Y
GND
3
B
BR
2
RSD
F5
FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
(FUEL PIPE)
VCNG2
Y
3
G–R
W–B
W
9 D
2
LG
Y
VOUT
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL VALVE
L–B
B
T1
THROTTLE
POSITION
SENSOR
BR
2
BR
B–Y
1
W–B
Y–G
6 IG1
BR
G–B
B–Y
F4
FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
(DELIVERY PIPE)
BR
F7
FUEL SHUTOFF VALVE
(FUEL PRESSURE
REGULATOR)
ENGINE CONTROL
B
B–Y
B
BR
L
3
AF+
AF–
1
7 IG1
I4
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C , E7 D
AF+
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
THCNG2
6 D
2
1
BR
I4
BR
PIM M 1
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
BR
B–Y
B–Y
2
1
A12
A/C SW
5
F/PS
B
2
4
21 A
MGC
8 IG1
7
IJ2
10 D
PRS
1 IG2
B
1 IG1
B–L
12 D
W–L
A/CS
B–R
B–R
A
G–O
(SHIELDED)
B–W
L
A
B–Y
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–O
10A
MIRROR–
HEATER
10A TAIL
BR
C1
CAMSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
BR
9 1C
3
1
5 C
G
18 C
A
9
IJ2
A
P2
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SW
W–L
L
I4
W–L
NE–
G
17 C
G
NE
L–Y
4 C
1
TO A/C
MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
1
10 A
2
L–Y
L
TE1
BR
TE1
C2
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
8
1
FROM
A/C DUAL
PRESSURE SW
B
L
15 B
B–R
E1
J8
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
15 A
(SHIELDED)
L–W
B–Y
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
3
R–B
LOCK
J12
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–B
R–B
R–W
L–R
10 B
+B
FROM MG
CLT RELAY
L
L–W
THR
12
H7
HEATER CONTROL SW
BR
A11
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
B–Y
BR
BR
BR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
BR
2
11 1J
D6
DIODE
(IDLE–UP)
2
I4
9 IG1
3 D
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C , E7 D
ELS
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
LOCK IN
12 B
PSW
10 IG3
1
C5
CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
BR
B–Y
ENGINE CONTROL
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
B–Y
B–Y
BR
12 IG2
BR
4
2
V–W
E1
+B
HT
OX
G–R
3
(SHIELDED)
W
B
(SHIELDED)
5 B
W
21 C
G–R
B
1 IG3
P–B
2 IG3
V–W
P–B
1
H6
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
9 A
5 A
16 A
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C , E7 D
2
1
I4
E03
16 B
BR
E02
22 C
BR
E01
13 C
BR
E04
13 A
BR
16 C
BR
E1
24 C
O
# 40
14 C
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR A
A
BR
2
A
BR
2
1
SIL
W
R
1
# 40+
(SHIELDED)
G
B–R
#30
25 C
W
I7
INJECTOR NO. 4
2
# 30+
15 C
I6
INJECTOR NO. 3
1
#20
11 C
BR
(SHIELDED)
# 20+
SPD
1 C
I5
INJECTOR NO. 2
I4
INJECTOR NO. 1
B–W
#10
12 C
L
(SHIELDED)
# 10+
2 C
OX2
(SHIELDED)
HT2
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
BR
A
BR
BR
A
BR
BR
A
BR
BR
BR
A
BR
A
A
BR
3 IG1
4 IG1
BR
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
W–B
A
BR
A
B–Y
IH
BR
BR
W–B
B–Y
EC
EC
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
BR
BR
7. 5A
OBD
15A
STOP
10 1J
7 1C
B
W
BR
BR
B–Y
V–W
V–W
CG
C A
A B
2 D
8 D
Y–R
J7 B
B B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
4 A
J6 A ,
BR
8 A
G–W
FUELW
G–W
FUEL
B–O
STP
G–R
C A
G–W
1
W–B
4
A A
TACH
S4
STOP LIGHT SW
BAT
J7 B
SG
5
16
J6 A ,
SIL
BR
I1
7
2
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
B–Y
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C , E7 D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
D3
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
W
W
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
W
J2
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
C
C
(SHIELDED)
G–R
8 1J
4 1R
7 1J
5 1R
BR
BR
G–W
BR
I6
6 IG3
Y–R
J23 A , J24 B
BR
A A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
W–B
BR
BR
C B
G–R
G–W
G–W
B–O
B–Y
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
ENGINE CONTROL
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
10A
GAUGE
2 1D
R–L
1 1J
R–L
D
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
D
3
IF1
V–W
F B
V–W
F B
R–L
R–L
V–W
7 C
14 B
15 B
6 C
J24 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C11 B , C12 C
SPEEDOMETER
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
TACHOMETER
IF1
P
10
7 IH1
2 IH1
P
IF1
L
6
5 C
BR
2 C
G–R
G–W
IF1
8 C
B–O
3 B
L
9
6 B
Y–R
D
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
2 IG2
FUEL
FUEL
R–L
COMBINATION METER
3
2
SI
V1
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION METER)
G–W
B–O
G–W
F A
J23 A
F A
Y–R
G–R
G–R
B–O
4 IH1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5 IG1
Y–R
R–L
Y–R
D
SE
IG+
1
R–L
BR
B–O
IG
SYSTEM OUTLINE
This system utilizes an engine control module and maintains overall control of the engine, transmission and so on. An outline
of the engine control is explained here.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) Engine coolant temp. signal circuit
The engine coolant temp. sensor detects the engine coolant temp. and has a built–in thermistor with a resistance which
varies according to the engine coolant temp. thus the engine coolant temp. is input in the form of a control signal into
TERMINAL THW of the engine control module.
(2) Intake air temp. signal circuit
The intake air temp. sensor detects the intake air temp. , which is input as a control signal into TERMINAL THA of the
engine control module.
(3) Oxygen sensor signal circuit
The oxygen density in the exhaust gases is detected and input as a control signal into TERMINAL OX2 of the engine
control module.
(4) RPM signal circuit
Camshaft position and crankshaft position are detected by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Camshaft position is input as a control signal to TERMINAL G of the engine control module, and engine RPM is input
into TERMINAL NE.
(5) Throttle signal circuit
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve opening angle, which is input as a control signal into TERMINAL
VTA of the engine control module.
(6) Vehicle speed signal circuit
The vehicle speed sensor, installed inside the transmission, detects the vehicle speed and inputs a control signal into
TERMINAL SPD of the engine control module.
(7) Park/Neutral position SW signal circuit
The Park/Neutral position SW detects whether the shift position are in neutral, parking or not, and inputs a control signal
into TERMINAL STA of the engine control module.
(8) A/C SW signal circuit
The A/C amplifier is built in the engine control module. The signal from the A/C SW is input into TERMINAL A/CS of the
engine control module.
(9) Battery signal circuit
Voltage is constantly applied to TERMINAL BATT of the engine control module. When the ignition SW is turned on, the
voltage for engine control module start–up power supply is applied to TERMINAL +B of engine control module via EFI
relay.
(10) Intake air volume signal circuit
Intake air volume is detected by the manifold absolute pressure sensor (for manifold pressure) and is input as a control
signal into TERMINAL PIM of the engine control module.
(11) Starter signal circuit
To confirm whether the engine is cranking, the voltage applied to the starter motor during cranking is detected and the
signal is input into TERMINAL NSW of the engine control module as a control signal.
(12) Electrical load signal circuit
The signal when systems such as the rear window defogger, headlights, etc. Which cause a high electrical burden are
on is input to TERMINAL ELS as a control signal.
(13) Air fuel ratio signal circuit
The air fuel ratio is detected and input as a control signal into TERMINAL AF+ of the engine control module.
ENGINE CONTROL
2. CONTROL SYSTEM
∗ SFI system
The SFI system monitors the engine condition through the signals, which are input from each sensor to the engine
control module. The best fuel injection volume is decided based on this data and the program memorized by the engine
control module, and the control signal is output to TERMINALS #10+, #20+, #30+ and #40+ of the engine control
module to operate the injector. (Inject the fuel). The SFI system produces control of fuel injection operation by the engine
control module in response to the driving conditions.
∗ ESA system
The ESA system monitors the engine condition through the signals, which are input to the engine control module from
each sensor the best ignition timing is detected according to this data and the memorized data in the engine control
module, and the control signal is output to TERMINALS IGT1 and IGT2. This signal controls the igniter to provide the
best ignition timing for the driving conditions.
∗ IAC system
The IAC system (Step motor type) increases the RPM and provides idling stability for fast idle–up when the engine is
cold and when the idle speed has dropped due to electrical load, etc. The engine control module evaluates the signals
from each sensor, outputs current to TERMINAL RSD , and controls the idle air control valve.
∗ Fuel control system
The engine control module operation outputs to TERMINAL FC and controls the CIR OPN relay. Thus controls the fuel
shutoff valve open and close.
∗ EGR control system
The EGR control system controls the VSV (EGR) by evaluating the signals from each sensor which are input to the
engine control module and by sending output to TERMINAL EGR of the engine control module.
∗ A/C conditioning operation system
In addition to the conventional A/C cut control, the engine control module performs the air conditioning operation as well
since the A/C amplifier function is built in it.
3. DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
With the diagnosis system, when there is a malfunctioning in the engine control module signal system, the malfunction
system is recorded in the memory. The malfunctioning system can then be found by reading the display (Code) of the
malfunction indicator lamp.
4. FAIL–SAFE SYSTEM
When a malfunction occurs in any system, if there is a possibility of engine trouble being caused by continued control based
on the signals from that system, the fail–safe system either controls the system by using data (Standard values) recorded in
the engine control module memory or else stops the engine.
SERVICE HINTS
E4 (A), E5 (B), E6 (C), E7 (D) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
BATT–E1 : Always 9.0–14.0 volts
+B–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
VC–E2 : 4.5– 5.5 volts with the ignition SW on
VTA–E2 : 0.3– 0.8 volts with the ignition SW on and throttle valve fully closed
3.2–4.9 volts with the ignition SW on and throttle valve open
PIM–E2 : 3.3– 3.9 volts with the ignition SW on
THA–E2 : 0.5–3.4 volts with the ignition SW on and intake air temp. 20°C (68°F)
THW–E2 : 0.2– 1.0 volts with the ignition SW on and coolant temp. 80°C (176°F)
STA–E1 : 6.0–14.0 volts with the engine cranking
W–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the no trouble and engine running
TE1–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the ignition SW on
NSW–E1 : 0– 3.0 volts with the ignition SW on and Park/Neutral position SW position P or N position
9.0–14.0 volts with the ignition SW on and except Park/Neutral position SW position P or N position
IGT1, IGT2–E1 : Pulse generation with the engine cranking or idling
#10+, #20+, #30+, #40+–E01, E02 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the ignition SW on
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
A8
28
Code
See Page
F8
Code
See Page
28
J9
31
A11
30
F9
A
28
J12
31
A12
30
F11
C
28
J15
31
C1
28
F17
32
J18
31
C2
28
H6
30
J19
31
C5
30
H7
30
J20
31
31
C11
B
30
I1
29
J21
C12
C
30
I2
29
J22
D1
28
I3
29
J23
A
31
D3
30
I4
29
J24
B
31
D6
30
I5
29
J34
32
E3
28
I6
29
M1
29
A
30
I7
29
P1
29
E5
B
30
I8
29
P2
29
E6
C
30
I10
30
S4
31
E7
D
30
J2
31
T1
29
F4
28
J3
31
V1
29
F5
28
J6
A
31
V2
29
F6
28
J7
B
31
F7
28
E4
J8
31
31
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
1
See Page
26
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1B
1C
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
24
Cowl Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
1J
1K
1R
1W
2A
2C
2F
2J
2K
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EB1
34
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
IB1
36
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
38
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
IH1
38
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IJ2
38
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IG1
IG2
IG3
ENGINE CONTROL
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
34
Intake Manifold
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IG
36
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IH
36
Cowl Side Panel RH
BK
40
Under the Left Center Pillar
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
E3
34
Cowl Wire
I5
I1
38
Cowl Wire
I6
I4
38
Engine Wire
See Page
38
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
MEMO
HEADLIGHT
2
4
1
40A
MAIN
15A
HEAD
(LH)
HEAD
RELAY
2
3 2G
4 2G
6 2G
R
R–B
B
J30
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
3
3
H1
HEADLIGHT
LH
B
1
1
R–L
R–B
2
3
H2
HEADLIGHT
RH
2
R–L
R–B
B
8 2C
R–W
3
8 2K
R–B
1
3 2B
15A
HEAD
(RH)
I11
INTEGRATION RELAY
1 A
F B
F B
D B
D B
J25 A , J26 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
F 9 A , F11 C
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
R–B
1 C
D A
F A
F A
R–L
4
R–Y
R–B
R–L
8
17
LOW
HIGH
FLASH
W–B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C15
COMBINATION SW
A
A
8
9
W–B
HEAD
R–L
3 IE1
TAIL
16
A
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
7
C11
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
DIMMER SW
B–G
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
13
OFF
8 1J
A
W–B
W–B
BATTERY
7 1J
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
IE
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
SERVICE HINTS
HEAD RELAY
2–1 : Closed with the light control SW at HEAD position or the dimmer SW at FLASH position
C15 COMBINATION SW
13–16 : Continuity with the light control SW at HEAD position
8–16 : Continuity with the dimmer SW at FLASH position
7–16 : Continuity with the dimmer SW at HIGH or FLASH position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C11
C15
Code
See Page
H2
28
J25
J26
30
I11
30
F9
A
28
J4
31
F11
C
28
J6
31
28
J9
31
H1
Code
30
See Page
A
31
B
31
J30
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1J
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2B
2C
2G
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IE1
See Page
36
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
36
Left Kick Panel
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
31
LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
B
B–R
4 1B
1
3 2B
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
25A
DOOR
2
10A
GAUGE
1
7. 5A
DOME
40A
MAIN
12 2J
3
2
1 1D
6 1C
G–R
4 1B
4
1
3
2
A
L–W
HEAD
RELAY
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8 2K
C B
J31 A , J32 B
B
B
R–B
G–R
A A
B–R
B–R
B
1 F
2 F
1 1W
13 A
2 B
1 C
J30
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E3
R
R–B
B–R
B–R
A
7
3 B
1
100A
ALT
1 A
F 9 A , F11 C , F14 F
1 B
10
4 B
G
I12 A
7 1S
C15
COMBINATION SW
W–B
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
I11 B ,
INTEGRATION RELAY
14
13
OFF
TAIL
R–G
8 1J
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
7 1J
6
R–Y
B–G
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
HEAD
16
A
BATTERY
A
W–B
1
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D7
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
SYSTEM OUTLINE
With the ignition SW turned on, the current flows to TERMINAL 7 of the integration relay through GAUGE fuse.
Voltage is applied at all times to TERMINAL (B) 2 of the integration relay through the TAILLIGHT relay coil side, and to
TERMINAL (B) 3 through the HEAD relay coil side.
1. NORMAL LIGHTING OPERATION
With the light control SW turned to TAIL position, a signal is input into TERMINAL (B) 1 of the integration relay. Due to this
signal, the current flowing to TERMINAL (B) 2 of the relay flows to TERMINAL (B) 1 to TERMINAL 14 of the light control SW
to TERMINAL 16 to GROUND, and TAILLIGHT relay causes taillights to turn on.
With the light control SW turned to HEAD position, a signal is input into TERMINALS (B) 1 and (B) 4 of the integration relay.
Due to this signal, the current flowing to TERMINALS (B) 3 and (B) 2 of the relay flows to TERMINALS (B) 4 and (B) 1 to
TERMINALS 13 and 14 of the light control SW to TERMINAL 16 to GROUND, and causes TAILLIGHT and HEAD relay to
turn the lights on.
2. LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF OPERATION
When the driver’s door is opened with the lights on and the ignition SW off, the relay is activated, and the current flow from
TERMINAL (B) 2 of the relay to TERMINAL (B) 1, and from TERMINAL (B) 3 to TERMINAL (B) 4 are cut, and all the lights
are turned off.
SERVICE HINTS
HEAD RELAY
2–1 : Closed with the light control SW at HEAD position or the dimmer SW at FLASH position
TAILLIGHT RELAY
3–5 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
D7 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH
1–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door open
I11 (B), I12 (A) INTEGRATION RELAY
7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
6–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door open
1–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
10–GROUND : Always continuity
(A)13–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(B) 2–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(B) 3–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(B) 4–GROUND : Continuity with the light control SW at HEAD position
(B) 1–GROUND : Continuity with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C15
D7
Code
30
I11
32
I12
See Page
B
30
A
Code
See Page
J30
31
30
J31
A
31
F9
A
28
J1
31
J32
B
31
F11
C
28
J6
31
F14
F
28
J9
31
LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1B
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2B
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1C
2J
2K
: GROUND POINTS
Code
IF
See Page
36
Ground Points Location
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
34
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
MEMO
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
2 1L
3 2K
W
H5
HAZARD SW
10A
HAZARD
G–R
7. 5A
TURN
10
8
C15
TURN SIGNAL SW
[COMB. SW]
OFF
RH
HAZARD
TURN
G–W
6
2
1
3
G–Y
1
5
G–B
G–R
9
G–B
7
T2
TURN SIGNAL
FLASHER
2
G–Y
LH
G–B
ON
C
D
G–B
3
G–Y
D
G–B
C
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–B
G–Y
D
5 1A
10 1C
8 1H
6 1H
G–B
W–B
C
8 1V
11 1S
6 1S
2 1A
G–B
G–Y
1 B
1 C
LH
RH
16 B
W–B
C11 B , C12 C
TURN SIGNAL INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
2
F2
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
3
W–B
5
R10
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
5
6
W–B
6
W–B
2
R8
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
3
W–B
IF
A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E2
A
EB
W–B
A
W–B
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B6
BM
W–B
F1
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
G–Y
B B
J25 A , J26 B
G–Y
G–B
G–B
B A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–Y
1 EB1
IE
SERVICE HINTS
T2 TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position or the hazard SW on
1–GROUND : Changes from 12 to 0 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position and the turn signal SW LH or RH position,
and with the hazard SW on
3–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
J26
See Page
C11
B
30
H5
30
B
31
C12
C
30
J4
31
R8
33
C15
30
J9
31
R10
33
F1
28
J15
31
T2
31
F2
28
J25
A
31
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1A
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1L
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2K
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1C
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
EB1
See Page
34
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
IE
36
Left Kick Panel
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
BM
40
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E2
See Page
34
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
Code
B6
See Page
40
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
STOP LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
15A
STOP
10A
GAUGE
1 1S
2 1D
W
R–L
7 1C
D
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
R–L
S4
STOP LIGHT
SW
R–L
D
7 C
1
C10 A , C12 C
G–W
REAR LIGHTS
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
Y–G
3 A
4 1R
5 IC2
G–W
Y–G
2 1S
L3
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
7
4
8
+
–
DELAY
HOLD
1
11
G–R
2
5
B6
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BK
W–B
W–B
A
BM
W–B
G–R
2
W–B
5
R10
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–R
2
W–B
W–B
1
R8
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
2
H8
HIGH MOUNTED
STOP LIGHT
R
B3
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current is applied at all times through the STOP fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the stop light SW.
When the ignition SW is turned on, current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor, and also
flows through the rear lights warning light to TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor.
STOP LIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
When the ignition SW is turned on and the brake pedal is pressed (Stop light SW on), if the stop light circuit is open, the
current flowing from TERMINAL 7 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 2 and 1 changes, so the light failure sensor
detects the disconnection and the warning circuit of the light failure sensor is activated.
As a result, the current flows from TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 11 to GROUND and turns the rear
lights warning light on. By pressing the brake pedal, the current flowing to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor keeps the
warning circuit on holding and the warning light on until the ignition SW is turned off.
SERVICE HINTS
S4 STOP LIGHT SW
2–1 : Closed with the brake pedal depressed
L3 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the stop light SW on
4, 8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
11–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
C10
C12
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A
30
J3
31
R8
33
C
30
J34
32
R10
33
32
L3
32
S4
31
H8
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1R
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IC2
See Page
36
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
BK
40
Under the Left Center Pillar
BM
40
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
B3
See Page
40
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
Code
B6
See Page
40
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
INTERIOR LIGHT
B
W–B
1 2A
1
SHORT
PIN
2
7. 5A
DOME
12 2J
R
B
R
1
1
2
R
B1
R
C17
CONDENSER
R
R
L3
LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR
R
L4
LUGGAGE
COMPARTMENT
LIGHT
OFF
ON
1 A
DOOR
2
I13
INTERIOR LIGHT
F 9 A , F11 C
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
1 C
1
2
R–W
B–G
W–B
1
R–Y
R–W
BATTERY
L5
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
FL MAIN
3. 0W
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
1
R–G
1
R–G
J31 A
1
2
R–G
D A
D A
E
D4
DIODE
(COURTESY)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J31 A , J32 B
E
4 1G
D
A
R–W
1
1
R–G
10
6 1F 12 1S
8 IM1
D8
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
11 1H
A
A
D7
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
D5
DIODE
(DOME)
1 1M
R–G
INTEGRATION RELAY
R–W
L–W
R–G
R
R–W
I12 A
R–W
1 1D
R–W
R
2 1M
R–W
C
B
D10
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
1
4
R–W
R
R–W
8 1G
2
G–R
1
R
9 1S
R–Y
5 1F
R
1 1W
R
10
I9
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
R
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 1J
D9
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
C11
OPEN DOOR
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
W–B
25A
DOOR
L–W
J31 A , J32 B
13 A
6
8 A
7 1S
R–W
1
2
E A
E A
D B
R–W
6 IM1
1
INTERIOR LIGHT
SERVICE HINTS
I12 (A) INTEGRATION RELAY
1–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
4–GROUND : Continuity with the one of each door (Front RH, rear LH and RH) open
6–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door open
10–GROUND : Always continuity
(A) 8–GROUND : Continuity with the front RH door open
D7, D8, D9, D10 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH, RH, REAR LH, RH
1–GROUND : Closed with the door open
L5 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SW
1–GROUND : Closed with the luggage compartment door open
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
D10
Code
32
See Page
C11
30
C17
32
F9
A
28
J31
A
31
D4
30
F11
C
28
J32
B
31
D5
30
D7
32
D8
32
D9
32
I9
J16
31
30
L3
32
30
L4
32
I13
32
L5
32
J9
31
I12
A
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1D
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1F
22
Roof Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2A
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2J
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1G
1H
1J
1M
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IM1
See Page
38
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
IF
See Page
36
Ground Points Location
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
B1
See Page
40
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
MEMO
ILLUMINATION
G
1
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
7. 5A
PANEL
2
4 1B
3
6 1C
4 1J
5 1D
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
6
1
3
7
A B
A B
A B
A A
A A
G
1
2
B
G
B B
G
B
1
4
B A
A18
ASHTRAY ILLUMINATION
2
2
B
B–G
1 A
6
B B
B4
BLOWER SW
I11
INTEGRATION
RELAY
B B
G
2
B B
B
G
G–R
B B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
A12
A/C SW
100A
ALT
B A
C8
CIGARETTE LIGHTER ILLUMINATION
G
B
F 9 A , F14 F
B–R
2 F
J13 A , J14 B
A
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
B–R
E3
1 F
G
G
A
R4
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
B–R
G–R
G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
C15
COMBINATION SW
14
OFF
A B
TAIL
A A
W–B
16
B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
A
J13 A , J14 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
A
B
8 1J
6 1V
7 1J
4 1H
B
W–B
BATTERY
HEAD
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
B
E
B
E
B
3
D
A
D
A
B
13
12
1
2
A
B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J16 A , J17 B
IE
G3
GLOVE BOX LIGHT AND SW
G
G
A A
C12
COMBINATION METER ILLUMINATION
[COMB. METER]
G
A A
2
G
W–B
5 B
G
G
A A
W–B
3
1
O2
A/T SHIFT LEVER ILLUMINATION
[O/D MAIN SW]
G
A B
B
B
10 A
R2 B , R3 A
2
RADIO AND PLAYER
G
A A
W–B
B
G
G
G
W–G
B
H5
HAZARD SW
G
J28 A , J29 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A B
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
D
A
3
E
1
T
ILL
R6
RHEOSTAT
ILLUMINATION
SERVICE HINTS
TAILLIGHT RELAY
5–3 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
C15 COMBINATION SW
14–16 : Continuity with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A12
30
H5
30
J17
B
31
A18
30
I11
30
J28
A
31
B4
30
J1
31
J29
B
31
C8
30
J4
31
C12
30
J6
31
R2
O2
B
31
31
C15
30
J9
31
R3
A
31
F9
A
28
J13
A
31
R4
31
F14
F
28
J14
B
31
R6
31
30
J16
A
31
G3
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1B
1C
1D
1H
1J
1V
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
36
Left Kick Panel
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
34
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
MEMO
TAILLIGHT
1
5
10A
TAIL
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
9 1C
8 1S
G–O
6 1C
G–R
4 1B
3
A
A
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
2
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
G
G
G–R
G–O
B–R
B1
2
J25 A , J26 B
W–B
16
FL MAIN
3. 0W
A
2
2
L1
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT LH
C15
COMBINATION SW
1
2
1
L2
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT RH
G
G–O
G–O
G
HEAD
1
G
I11
INTEGRATION RELAY
TAIL
F2
FRONT PARKING LIGHT RH
B–G
1 A
B5
C B
14
OFF
F1
FRONT PARKING LIGHT LH
100A
ALT
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
C B
1
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
2 F
F 9 A , F14 F
B–R
1 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
B–R
E3
A A
2
1
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
8 1J
BATTERY
W–B
7 1J
E2
B5
W–B
A
W–B
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
EB
W–B
B5
3
1
3
5
B6
W–B
BM
G
1
W–B
A
BK
W–B
G–O
G–O
G
G–O
DELAY
+
–
L3
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
3
TAIL
SIDE
MARKER
R10
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
TAIL
SIDE
MARKER
B3
W–B
4
G–O
W–B
3
B4
R8
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
G–O
Y–G
G
G
Y–G
R–L
G
W–B
W–B
W–B
4
R9
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–O
W–B
W–B
R7
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
R–L
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
10A
GAUGE
2
1D
R–L
1 1S
D
D
B1
8
9
11
B3
G
3
5
B6
A
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 C
REAR LIGHTS
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
C10 A , C12 C
3 A
5 IC2
4
TAILLIGHT
SYSTEM OUTLINE
When the light control SW is turned to TAIL or HEAD position. The current flows to TERMINAL 3 of the light failure sensor
through the TAIL fuse.
When the ignition SW is turned on, the current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor, and
also flows through the rear lights warning light to TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor.
TAILLIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
With the ignition SW on and the light control SW turned to TAIL or HEAD position, if the taillight circuit is open, the light failure
sensor detects the failure by the change in current flowing from TERMINAL 3 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 9, and
the warning circuit of the light failure sensor is activated.
As a result, the current flows from TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 11 to GROUND and turns the rear
lights warning light on, which remains on until the light control SW is turned off
SERVICE HINTS
TAILLIGHT RELAY
5–3 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
L3 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
4, 8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
3–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
11–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
C10
A
30
J1
31
L1
32
C12
C
30
J3
31
L2
32
C15
30
J6
31
L3
32
F1
28
J9
31
R7
33
F2
28
J12
31
R8
33
F9
A
28
J25
A
31
R9
33
F14
F
28
J26
B
31
R10
33
I11
30
J34
32
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
22
1C
22
1D
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IC2
See Page
36
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
BK
40
Under the Left Center Pillar
BM
40
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
E2
34
Engine Room Main Wire
B4
E3
34
Cowl Wire
B5
40
Floor Wire
B1
B3
B6
See Page
40
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
BACK–UP LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
10A
GAUGE
R–L
1 1J
F
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
F
R–L
C
J23
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
C
2 IG2
3 IG3
R–L
5 1V
13 1S
D
R–B
R–B
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
D
R–B
R–B
R9
BACK–UP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
8
1
3
W–B
2
W–B
B5
W–B
R7
BACK–UP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
P1
BACK–UP LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW]
R–B
B4
A
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BK
1
3
SERVICE HINTS
P1 BACK–UP LIGHT SW [PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
2–8 : Closed with the shift lever at R position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
J19
31
J23
J24
Code
See Page
J34
32
31
P1
29
31
R7
33
Code
R9
See Page
33
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IG2
IG3
See Page
38
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
BK
See Page
40
Ground Points Location
Under the Left Center Pillar
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
B4
See Page
40
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
Code
B5
See Page
40
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
WIPER AND WASHER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
25A
WIPER
E
B
E
A
1
1A
L
L
J25 A , J26 B
4 1C
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
M
W2
WASHER
MOTOR
1
EW
L
L–W
WF
WIPER SW
WASHER SW OFF
6
HI
LO
INT
WF
11
L–W
EW
2
W–B
16
L–Y
+1
7
L–B
+2
8
L–O
+B
17
L
IJ1
+S
INT1
INT2
B1
OFF
ON
+B
A
L
A
L
L–O
L–B
A
C13
WIPER AND WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
3
5
2
1
+2
+1
B
S
M
E
4
W–B
F3
FRONT WIPER
MOTOR
W–B
10 2J
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
4 2F
W–B
A
L–Y
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
+2
L
+1
+S
EB
SYSTEM OUTLINE
With the ignition SW turned on, the current flows to TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW, TERMINAL 2 of the washer
motor and TERMINAL 2 of the front wiper motor through the WIPER fuse.
1. LOW SPEED POSITION
With the wiper and washer SW turned to LO position, the current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to
TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 5 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 4 to GROUND and causes the front wiper motor to run
at low speed.
2. HIGH SPEED POSITION
With the wiper and washer SW turned to HI position, the current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to
TERMINAL 8 to TERMINAL 3 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 4 to GROUND and causes the front wiper motor to run
at high speed.
3. INT POSITION
With the wiper and washer SW turned to INT position, the wiper relay operates and current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the
wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND. This activates the intermittent circuit and the current flows from
TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 5 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 4 to
GROUND and the wiper operates. Intermittent operation is controlled by a condenser charge and discharge function in the
relay.
4. WASHER CONTINUOUS OPERATION
With the wiper and washer SW pulled to WASHER position (Washer SW ON position), the current flows from the WIPER
fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the washer motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 11 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 2 to
GROUND and causes the washer motor to run and the window washer to spray. Simultaneously, current flows from the
WIPER fuse to TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 5 of the front wiper motor to
TERMINAL 4 to GROUND, causing the wiper to function.
SERVICE HINTS
C13 WIPER AND WASHER SW [COMB. SW]
2–GROUND : Always continuity
17–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the wiper and washer SW at LO position
Approx. 12 volts every approx. 1.6 to 10.7 seconds intermittently with the wiper and washer SW at INT position
16–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position and unless the front wiper motor at STOP position
8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the wiper and washer SW at HI position
F3 FRONT WIPER MOTOR
1–2 : Closed unless the front wiper motor at STOP position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
C13
30
J15
31
F3
28
J25
A
31
J9
31
J26
B
31
Code
W2
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1A
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2F
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2J
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1C
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IJ1
See Page
38
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
See Page
29
WIPER AND WASHER
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
MEMO
POWER WINDOW
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
10A
GAUGE
30A
POWER
B
B
L
B
L
25A
DOOR
J33
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
L
2
P8
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
10
11
BW
10 ID2
BW
FRONT LH
5
DOWN
L
1
POWER
RELAY
5 1G
7 1J
3 1S
13 1G
W–B
L
L
C B
A A
L–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J31 A , J32 B
L–W
1 1D
3
R–B
12 1G
2
R
DD
5
G
10
12 A
DU
1
W–B
7
13 A
E
4
W–B
E
3
6
J33
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L
8 A
I12 A
R–G
INTEGRATION RELAY
7 1S
A
A
A
L
E A
W–B
D B
R–G
W–B
G
W–B
D8
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
R–G
6 IM1
D7
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
R
1
20 ID1
7 1G
1
3 1V
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
W–B
R–G
J31 A , J32 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
ID
1
M
2
P9
POWER WINDOW
MOTOR FRONT LH
P8
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
FRONT RH
REAR LH
REAR RH
WINDOW LOCK SW
LOCK
NORMAL
PU
PD
RLU
RRD
R–B
7 ID2
9 ID2
6 ID2
12 ID2
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
L
R–B
G–B
5 ID2
G–B
R–Y
13
R–Y
8
G–Y
R–L
RRU
12
G–Y
11 ID2
RLD
9
R–L
G–W
6
G–W
14
5 IM1
7 IM1
L
L
R–Y
2 BB1
3 BB1
1 BB1
2 BA1
3 BA1
1 BA1
2
M
1
P10
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
FRONT RH
5
2
M
1
P11
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR LH
4
3
SD
B
U
D
1
5
2
M
1
P12
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR RH
DOWN
R–B
G–B
D
2
SU
R
U
1
DOWN
3
B
UP
4
SD
R
R
G
1
R–B
G–B
D
2
SU
G
U
3
P5
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW FRONT RH
4
B
DOWN
R–L
2
SD
UP
5
SU
UP
IL2
G
6
L
IL2
P6
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR LH
5
L
IL2
G–W
4
L
L
P7
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR RH
G–Y
L
9 IM1
R–B
5 IC1
G–B
1 IC1
L
R–L
G–W
A
POWER WINDOW
SYSTEM OUTLINE
With the ignition SW turned on, current flows through the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 7 of the integration relay to TERMINAL
(A) 12 to TERMINAL 1 of the POWER relay to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND, this activates the relay and the current flowing to
TERMINAL 5 of the relay from the POWER fuse flows to TERMINAL 3 of the relay to TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power
window master SW.
1. MANUAL OPERATION (DRIVER’S WINDOW)
With the ignition SW turned on and with the power window master SW (Driver’s) pulled to the up side the current flowing from
TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW flows to TERMINAL 1 of the master SW to TERMINAL 1 of the
power window motor to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 5 of the master SW to TERMINALS 3 and 4 to GROUND and causes
the power window motor to rotate in the up direction. The window ascends only while the SW is being pushed.
In down operation, the flow of current from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW to TERMINAL 5 of the
master SW causes the flow of current from TERMINAL 2 of the power window motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 1 of the
master SW to TERMINALS 3 and 4 to GROUND, flowing in the opposite detection to manual up operation and causing the
motor to rotate in reverse, lowering the window.
2. AUTO DOWN OPERATION (DRIVER’S WINDOW)
When the driver’s window SW is pushed strongly to the down side, the current flowing to TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the
power window master SW flows to the down contact point and auto down contact point of the driver’s SW.
This activates the relay (Down side) inside the power window master SW and the hold circuit also turns on at the same time,
so the relay (Down side) remains activated even when the SW is released.
Current flows at this time from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW to TERMINAL 5 to TERMINAL 2 of
the power window motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 1 of the power window master SW to TERMINALS 3 and 4 to
GROUND, so the motor continues to operate until the driver’s window is fully down.
When the driver’s window finishes down operation and the hold circuit goes off, so the relay (Down side) also turns off. This
stops the current flowing from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW to TERMINAL 5 is cut off, so the
power window motor stops and auto down operation stops.
When the driver’s SW is pulled to the up side during auto down operation, the hold circuit is turned off so the current flowing
from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW to TERMINAL 5 is cut off and the power window motor stops.
If the SW remains pulled up the relay (Up side) is activated, so current flows from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power
window master SW to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 1 of the power window motor to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 5 to
TERMINALS 3 and 4 to GROUND, the power window motor rotates in the up direction and manual up operation occurs
while the SW is pulled up.
3. MANUAL OPERATION (FRONT RH WINDOW)
With the power window control SW front RH pulled to the up side, the current flowing from TERMINAL 4 of the power window
control SW flows to TERMINAL 3 of the power window control SW to TERMINAL 2 of the power window motor to TERMINAL
1 to TERMINAL 1 of the power window control SW to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 6 of the master SW to TERMINALS 3 and
4 to GROUND and causes the power window motor front RH to rotate in the up direction. The up operation continues only
while the power window control SW is pulled to the up side. When the window descends, the current flowing to the motor
flows in the opposite direction, from TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 2, and the motor rotates in reverse. When the window lock
SW is pushed to the lock side, the ground circuit to the front RH window becomes open.
As a result, even if Open/Close operation of the front RH window is tried, the current from TERMINALS 3 and 4 of the power
window master SW is not grounded and the motor does not rotate, so the front RH window can not be operated and window
lock occurs.
4. MANUAL OPERATION (REAR LH, RH WINDOW)
With the power window control SW rear LH, RH pulled to the up side, the current flowing from TERMINAL 3 of the power
window control SW flows to TERMINAL 1 of the power control SW to TERMINAL 2 of the power window motor to TERMINAL
1 to TERMINAL 5 of the power window control SW to TERMINAL 4 to TERMINAL 12 or 13 of the master SW to TERMINALS
3 and 4 to GROUND and causes the power window motor rear LH, RH to rotate in the up direction. The up operation
continues only while the power window control SW is pulled to the up side. When the window descends, the current flowing
to the motor flows in the opposite direction, from TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 2, and the motor rotates in reverse. When the
window lock SW is pushed to the lock side, the ground circuit to the rear LH, RH window becomes open.
As a result, even if Open/Close operation of the rear LH, RH window is tried, the current from TERMINALS 3 and 4 of the
power window master SW is not grounded and the motor does not rotate, so the rear LH, RH window can not be operated
and window lock occurs.
5. KEY OFF POWER WINDOW OPERATION
With the ignition SW turned from on to off, the integration relay operates and current flows from the DOOR fuse to
TERMINAL (A) 13 of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 12 to TERMINAL 1 of the power relay to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND for
about 43 seconds. The same as normal operation, the current flows from the POWER fuse to TERMINAL 5 of the power
relay to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW and TERMINAL 4 (Front RH) or 3 (Rear
LH, RH) of the power window control SW. As a result, for about 43 seconds after the ignition SW is turned off, the functioning
of this relay makes it possible to raise and lower the power window. Also, by opening the front doors (Door courtesy SW on)
within about 43 seconds after turning the ignition SW to off, a signal is input to TERMINAL 6 or (A) 8 of the integration relay.
As a result, the relay turned off, and up and down movement of the power window stops.
SERVICE HINTS
P8 POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
10, 11–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position or key off power window operation
3, 4–GROUND : Always continuity
1–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the power window master SW (Driver’s window) at UP position
5–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the power window master SW (Driver’s window)
at DOWN or AUTO DOWN position
WINDOW LOCK SW
Open with the window lock SW at LOCK position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
D7
32
D8
Code
J32
See Page
B
Code
See Page
31
P9
33
32
J33
32
P10
33
30
P5
33
P11
33
J3
31
P6
33
P12
33
J9
31
P7
33
31
P8
33
I12
A
J31
A
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IC1
ID1
ID2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
36
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
36
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IL2
38
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IM1
38
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
40
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BB1
40
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
ID
36
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IF
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7
W–B
2
A
A
W–B
3
1
7
1G
IL1
3
1V
3
2
IL1
A
13
3
1
W–B
W–B
ID
9 A
L–R
13 A
IL1
A
J33
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
20
12
6
5
3
A
A
A
20 ID1
IL1
II
INTEGRATION RELAY
LG
IL1
3 ID2
A
J35
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8
ID2
L–R
D
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–W
25A
DOOR
L–B
L–R
12 A
L–R
4
I12 A
L–W
5 1G
L–B
3 ID1
G
POWER
RELAY
L–R
4 ID1
A
LG
1
D14
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT LH
L–W
B
G
B
A
UNLOCK
B
W–B
B
5 1M
R–B
5
LG
10
LOCK
B
L–B
J27
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5 A
L
3 1M
D13
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
12 ID1
L
U1
UNLOCK WARNING SW
L
E
1
UNLOCK
E
2
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4 A
R–G
W–B
D12
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
L–W
LOCK
D
R–G
W–B
UNLOCK
3 A
L–W
TO POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW
30A
POWER
W–B
4
G
7 1J
J27
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 A
G
12 1G
W–B
13 ID1
E
L–W
G
2
W–B
G
1 A
LG
L
J31 A , J32 B
3
D11
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
L–W
LOCK
UNLOCK
D
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5
W–B
W–B
2
P8
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LH
[POWER WINDOW MASTER SW]
LG
LOCK
W–B
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
1
10A
GAUGE
2
1 1D
C B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A A
7
L–R
F
F
2
3
4
L–B
R–G
11 ID1
M
1
W–B
D8
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
1
R–G
D7
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
1
R–G
6 IM1
D B
J31 A , J32 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
E A
7 1S
I12 A
L–B
6
IC2
L–B
L–Y
W–B
Y
11
IL1
7 BB1
4 BB1
2
3
4
2
3
1
M
1
M
4
W–B
6 BB1
W–B
A
W–B
BK
B2
W–B
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IJ
3 IM1
L–Y
IL2
6 BA1
W–B
W–B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4
L–Y
J10 A , J11 B
D16
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR LH
5 BB1
L–Y
W–B
M
D
A
D
A
3
D17
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW REAR RH
E
B
IL2
Y
L–Y
1
7
L–B
L–B
3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–R
L–R
2
1
IM1
L–B
L–Y
4 BA1
L–Y
7 BA1
C
L–B
J28 A , J29 B
2 IC2
5 BA1
C
B
C
B
L–Y
L–B
J27
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–B
L–B
C
L–R
L–B
L–R
2
IM1
L–R
L–R
7
IC2
B
B
B
B
L–R
L–R
L–Y
10 A
C
A
C
A
C
A
B
A
B
A
B
A
8 A
Y
L–R
L–B
11 A
7 A
L–R
L–R
6
D15
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW FRONT RH
6 A
INTEGRATION RELAY
BL
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current always flows to TERMINAL (A) 13 of the integration relay through the DOOR fuse.
When the ignition SW is turned on, the current flowing through the GAUGE Fuse flows to TERMINAL 7 of the integration
relay to TERMINAL (A) 12 to the POWER relay (Coil side) to GROUND.
1. MANUAL LOCK OPERATION
When the door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock SW are operated to LOCK position, a lock signal is input to
TERMINAL (A) 1 or (A) 3 of the integration relay and causes the relay to function. Current flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 of
the relay to TERMINAL (A) 6 to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL (A) 7 of the relay to
TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and the door lock motor causes the door to lock.
2. MANUAL UNLOCK OPERATION
When the door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock SW are operated to UNLOCK position, an unlock signal is input
to TERMINAL (A) 2, (A) 4 or (A) 5 of the integration relay and causes the relay to function. Current flows from TERMINAL (A)
13 of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 7 to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL (A) 6 of the relay
to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and door lock motors causes door to unlock.
3. DOUBLE OPERATION UNLOCK OPERATION
When the door key lock and unlock SW front LH is turned to the unlock side, only the driver’s door to unlock. Turning the
door key lock and unlock SW front LH to the unlock side causes a signal to be input to TERMINAL (A) 4 of the relay, and if
the signal is input again within 3 seconds by turning the SW to the unlock side again, current flows from TERMINAL (A) 7 of
the integration relay to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL (A) 6 of
the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND, causing the door lock motors to operate and unlock the doors.
4. IGNITION KEY REMINDER OPERATION
When the door is locked using the door lock knob with the ignition key remaining in the key cylinder and door opened, it is
automatically unlocked. Additionally, if lock operation is made by the door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock, after
the lock operation is completed, the doors are unlocked automatically.
SERVICE HINTS
I12 (A) INTEGRATION RELAY
10–GROUND : Always continuity
6–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door open
7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
(A)13–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 6–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts 0.2 seconds with following operation
∗ Door lock control SW locked
∗ Locking the front LH, RH door cylinder with key
(A) 1–GROUND : Continuity with the door lock control SW locked
(A) 8–GROUND : Continuity with the front RH door open
(A) 2–GROUND : Continuity with the door lock control SW unlocked
(A) 5–GROUND : Continuity with the front RH door lock cylinder unlocked with key
(A) 4–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door lock cylinder unlocked with key
(A) 3–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH, RH door lock cylinder locked with key
(A) 7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts 0.2 seconds with following operation
∗ Door lock control SW unlocked
∗ Door lock control SW locked with the ignition key in cylinder and the front LH door open
(Ignition key reminder function)
∗ Door lock knob locked with the ignition key in cylinder and the front LH door open
(Ignition key reminder function)
∗ Unlocking the front LH, RH door cylinder with key
D7, D8 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH,RH
1–GROUND : Closed with the each door open
D11, D12 DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SW FRONT LH,RH
1–2 : Closed with the door lock cylinder locked with key
1–3 : Closed with the door lock cylinder unlocked with key
D14, D15 DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SW FRONT LH,RH
1–4 : Closed with the door lock knob UNLOCK position
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
1–2 : Closed with the ignition key in cylinder
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
D7
32
Code
See Page
D17
I12
A
Code
See Page
32
J29
B
31
D8
32
30
J31
A
31
D11
32
J5
31
J32
B
31
D12
32
J9
31
J33
32
D13
32
J10
A
31
J34
32
D14
32
J11
B
31
J35
32
D15
32
31
P8
33
D16
32
31
U1
31
J27
J28
A
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
1J
1M
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IC2
ID1
ID2
IL1
IL2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
36
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
36
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
38
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IM1
38
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
40
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BB1
40
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
ID
36
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
36
Right Kick Panel
BK
40
Under the Left Center Pillar
BL
40
Under the Right Center Pillar
II
IJ
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
B2
See Page
40
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor No.2 Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
7 AM2
5A
STARTER
ST2
B–R
W–R
B–R
W–R
8 2J
B
B–Y
B–Y
B–R
B
B B
B–W
1 2A
J23 A , J24 B
B A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
30A
AM2
T1
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
B–Y
W–B
W–B
4 2L
BR
7 2K
12 A
22 A
2
1
E2
VC
VTA
1
3
2
G–B
2 2J
B
5 2C
BR
4 2F
I4
LG
3
Y
2
5 1B
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5
B–W
1
3 1J
E3
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
BR
7 1W
I10
IGNITION SW
EFI
RELAY
5 1K
5A
IGN
20A
EFI
IG2 6
1 B
11 B
9 B
4 B
F 9 A , F11 C
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
1 C
+B
6 A
1 A
+B1
BATT
1 A
NSW
VC
VTA
E2
THW
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
A
A
A
BR
W–B
E1 A , E2 B
EB
J18
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
P
1 A
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
S1
BR
S2
BR
3 B
ECT
LOCK–UP
L–B
A
W
L–B
1 B
E1
16 C
BR
BR
L–B
Y–B
6
C16
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
E05
26 C
3 IG1
B
L–R
14
OD
E04
13 A
B
13
IDL
W–B
SL
8 C
B
B
NO. 2
BATTERY
S1
7 C
V
7 IG2
FL MAIN
3. 0W
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–B
S2
6 C
BR
OD1
20 A
NO. 1
B–G
IDLO
3 A
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
EC
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
R–L
15A
STOP
10A
GAUGE
1 1J
2 1D
R–L
W
7 1C
2
D
R–L
F B
S4
STOP LIGHT SW
F B
J24 B
D
R–L
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Y
G–W
1
L–W
R–L
4 1R
R–B
17 A
9 A
L
2
R
3
IF1
COMBINATION METER
D
SPD
D
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
7 C
5 C
12 A
P
7 IH1
2 IH1
P
G–O
6 C
L
15 B
R–L
7 A
G–O
OD2
22 C
BR
E02
13 C
BR
E01
16 B
BR
E03
14 B
R–L
L
STP
J23 A , J24 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C10 A , C11 B , C12 C
D
R–B
O/D OFF
V–W
18 A
C
A
R–L
R–B
19 A
R–B
V–W
L–W
4 A
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B V–W
A
B
C
A
SPEEDOMETER
Y
R–L
G–W
3
2
SI
IF1
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG+
1
C
C
C
G–O
R–L
EC
SE
V1
VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION
METER)
BR
BR
BR
G–O
11
BR
C B
J23 A , J24 B
A A
2 IG2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–W
5 1R
IG
G–O
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
R–L
R–L
P1
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
2
RB
7
3 IG3
4 IG2
E
L–W
L–W
A
D
A
R–B
D
D
R
E
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
Y
G–W
1 IH1
B–R
9 IG2
L–W
6 IG2
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5 IG2
Y
G–W
PL
8
R–B
RL
9
R
NL
10
B–R
DL
3
L–W
2L
4
Y
LL
R–B
B–R
IF1
15
10 A
8 A
2
16 B
C10 A , C11 B , C12 C
W–B
COMBINATION METER
A
2
4
O2
O/D MAIN
SW
W–B
A
A
W–B
G–O
IE
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF1
G–W
R–B
7 A
R
11 A
N
6 A
D
R
10 1H
B–R
14
O
IF1
9 A
P
Y
13
5 1V
Y
IF1
L
16
G–W
R–B
L–W
R–B
SYSTEM OUTLINE
The electronically controlled transmission, however, electrically controls the line pressure and lock–up pressure etc., through
the solenoid valve. Engine control module controls of the solenoid valve based on the input signals from each sensor which
makes smooth driving possible by shift selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that
time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the engine control module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions,
based on input signals from the engine coolant temp. sensor to TERMINAL THW of the engine control module, and also the
input signals to TERMINAL SPD of the engine control module from the vehicle speed sensor devoted to the electronically
controlled transmission. Current is then output to the electronically controlled transmission solenoid. When shifting to 1st
gear, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the engine control module to TERMINAL (B) 3 of the solenoid to GROUND, and
continuity to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd gear, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the engine control module to TERMINAL (B) 3 of the solenoid to
GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the engine control module to TERMINAL (B) 1 of the solenoid to GROUND, and
continuity to solenoids No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd gear, there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2, causing the shift.
Shifting into 4th gear (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 solenoid.
2. LOCK–UP OPERATION
When the engine control module judges from each signal that lock–up operation conditions have been met, current flows
from TERMINAL SL of the engine control module to TERMINAL (A) 1 of the electronically controlled transmission solenoid to
GROUND, causing continuity to the lock–up solenoid and causing lock–up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop light SW on) when driving in lock–up condition, a signal is input to TERMINAL STP of
the engine control module, the engine control module operates and continuity to the lock–up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
∗ O/D main SW on
When the O/D main SW is turned on (O/D off indicator light turns off), a signal is input into TERMINAL OD2 of the engine
control module and engine control module operation causes gear shift when the conditions for overdrive are met.
∗ O/D main SW off
When the O/D main SW is turned to off, the current through the O/D off indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to
GROUND, causing the indicator light to light up. At the same time, a signal is input into TERMINAL OD2 of the engine
control module and engine control module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
SERVICE HINTS
E4 (A), E5 (B), E6 (C) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
S1, S2–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the solenoid on
0–1.5 volts with the solenoid off
L–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at L position
2–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at 2 position
R–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at R position
STP–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the brake pedal depressed
THW–E2 : 0.2–1.0 volts with the ignition SW on and coolant temp. 80°C (176°F)
VTA–E2 : 0.3–0.8 volts with the throttle valve fully closed
3.2–4.9 volts with the throttle valve fully opened
VC–E2 : 4.5–5.5 volts
OD2–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the O/D main SW turned on
0–3.0 volts with the O/D main SW turned off
+B–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts
O2 O/D MAIN SW
2–4 : Closed with the O/D main SW off, open with the O/D main SW on
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
C10
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A
30
F9
C11
B
30
F11
C12
C
30
I10
30
J3
31
O2
31
C16
A
28
J22
31
C
28
J23
A
31
30
J24
B
31
E1
A
28
J4
31
P1
29
E2
B
28
J5
31
S4
31
28
J15
31
T1
29
E4
E3
A
30
J18
31
V1
29
E5
B
30
J19
31
E6
C
30
J20
31
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1B
1C
1D
1H
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
24
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
24
Cowl Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
1J
1K
1R
1V
1W
2A
2C
2F
2J
2K
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IF1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
38
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
38
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IG1
IG2
IG3
IH1
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
34
Intake Manifold
IE
36
Left Kick Panel
IG
36
Instrument Panel Brace RH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I4
See Page
38
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
MEMO
CRUISE CONTROL
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
10A
GAUGE
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
D
R–L
R–L
R–L
F
R–L
D
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
2
D
10
B–R
R–L
F
P1
D POSITION SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
2 IG2
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 1J
R–L
D
2 1D
B–R
R–L
9 IG2
A
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C11 B , C12 C
COMBINATION METER
A
C16
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
CRUISE
V–W
O
D
O
V–W
2
D
SE
LG–R
B
B
B
11 IG3
10
4
11
LG–R
LG–R
V1
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION METER)
SI
D
O
3
5 IE2
LG–R
P
IF1
J1
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
L
3
O
2 IH1
SPD
A/D
IG+
TC
TC
B
B
D2
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
CCS
11
10
5
4
CMS
CCS
RESUME/
ACCEL
SET/
COAST
CANCEL
EP
3
BR
1
R–L
CMS
12
W
BR
TC
5
W–L
P
PI
4
CRUISE
10 C
V–W
14 B
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
5 C
V–W
6 C
L
D
15 B
7 IH1
3
J2
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
SPEEDOMETER
B–R
7 C
C14
CRUISE CONTROL
SW [COMB. SW]
W–B
IG
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
E4 A , E6 C
15A
ECU–IG
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
S2
9 1J
7 1C
1
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
W
B
B–R
L–B
L–B
S2
6 C
Y–B
OD1
20 A
L–R
IDLO
3 A
E2
ELECTRONICALLY
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
SOLENOID
15A
STOP
L–B
B
C
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 IG2
OD
6
9
ECT
GND
MO
15
MC
L
7
W–B
W–B
W–B
A A
8 1J
1
2
A
A
4
1
G–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
R–Y
J7 B
R–B
J6 A ,
R–G
A B
A A
2
W
S4
STOP LIGHT SW
3
A A
STP–
8
G–B
16
B
G–W
IDL
G–W
C16
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
14
B–R
13
L–B
C
3
W–B
7 1J
A
W–B
IF
J9
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
5 1R
M
4 1R
C3
CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
4
W–B
J23
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
CRUISE CONTROL
SYSTEM OUTLINE
The cruise control system is a constant vehicle speed controller which controls the opening angle of the engine throttle valve
by the SW, and allows driving at a constant speed without depressing the accelerator pedal.
SET CONTROL
When the SET/COAST SW is operated while traveling with the CRUISE SW on, the speed when the SET/COAST SW is
operated to off is memorized, and the vehicle speed is controlled at that speed.
COAST CONTROL
When the SET/COAST SW is operated to on, the motor in the actuator rotates the throttle valve until it is closed fully to
decrease the vehicle speed, and the speed when the SET/COAST SW is operated to off is memorized, and the vehicle
speed is controlled at that speed.
Furthermore, every time the SET/COAST SW is operated momentarily (Approx. 0.5 sec.) to on, the memorized vehicle
speed is decreased by approx. 1.5 km/h (0.9 mph).
ACCEL CONTROL
When the RESUME/ACCEL SW is operated to on, the motor in the actuator rotates the throttle valve to open direction to
increase the vehicle speed, and the speed when the RESUME/ACCEL SW is operated to off is memorized, and the vehicle
speed is controlled at that speed.
Furthermore, every time the RESUME/ACCEL SW is operated momentarily (Approx. 0.5 sec.) to on, the memorized vehicle
speed is increased by approx. 1.5 km/h (0.9 mph).
MANUAL CANCEL MECHANISM
While traveling with the cruise control, if the following signal is input, the magnetic clutch of the actuator is cut, the motor is
controlled to close the throttle valve, and the cruise control is canceled.
(1) Stop lamp SW is on (Brake pedal is depressed)
(2) The CANCEL SW of the control SW is on
(3) CRUISE SW is off
RESUME CONTROL
After canceling the cruise control by the Manual Cancel operation, (Except when the CRUISE SW is off) if the vehicle speed
is above the minimum speed limit (Approx. 40km/h, 25mph), operating the RESUME/ACCEL SW to on from off will cause the
system to accelerate and resume to the vehicle speed before manual cancellation.
OVERDRIVE FUNCTION
The overdrive may be cut on an uphill grade, while traveling with the cruise control.
After the overdrive is cut, if the vehicle speed reaches the overdrive resume speed (Set speed minus 2 km/h (1.2 mph) ), and
if the system determines that the uphill grade has finished, the overdrive will resume after the overdrive timer operation.
AUTO CANCEL OPERATION
If any of the following conditions are detected, the set speed is erased and the control is canceled.
(1) Overcurrent to the magnetic clutch traction transistor
(2) The motor does not operate
(3) Short in the magnetic clutch
(4) Disconnection in the magnetic clutch (Includes blown stop lamp fuse)
(5) No vehicle speed signal input
(6) Ground short of the control SW input
(7) The actual vehicle speed becomes slower than the minimum speed limit
SERVICE HINTS
C3 CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
3–4 : Approx. 38.5 Ω
C14 CRUISE CONTROL SW [COMB. SW]
5–3 : Continuity with the CRUISE SW on
4–3 : Approx. 418 Ω with the CANCEL SW on
Approx. 68 Ω with the RESUME/ACCEL SW on
Approx. 198 Ω with the SET/COAST SW on
C16 CRUISE CONTROL ECU
9–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
10–GROUND : Approx. 418 Ω with the CANCEL SW on in the cruise control SW
Approx. 198 Ω with the SET/COAST SW on in the cruise control SW
Approx. 68 Ω with the RESUME/ACCEL SW on in the cruise control SW
16–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C3
28
Code
E6
See Page
C
Code
See Page
30
J19
31
C11
B
30
J1
31
J22
31
C12
C
30
J2
31
J23
31
C14
30
31
J24
31
C16
30
J6
A
31
P1
29
D1
28
J7
B
31
S4
31
D2
30
J9
31
V1
29
E2
28
J12
31
30
J15
31
E4
A
J3
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
1R
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE2
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
IF1
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
38
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
38
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IG2
IG3
IH1
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IG
36
Instrument Panel Brace RH
ABS
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 44)
1
8
IJ2
R–L
BR
60A
FL ABS
C A
GR–R
2
4 IG3
3
4
3
3
3
E1
WB
(SHORT PIN)
ABS
6
3
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
23
3
TC
14
4
TC
1
TS
11
W–L
W–R
GR–L
3
W–B
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D2
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
3
GR–R
BR
2
A
5
2
ABS MOTOR
RELAY
6 IG3
4
WA
16
22
G–B
1
R–Y
3
ABS SOL RELAY
BR
1
LG–R
3
B B
LG–R
3
BR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
J7 B
R–L
J6 A ,
A
R–L
11 IG3
8 IG3
5 IG3
IJ1
BR
B
B
LG–R
GR–R
7 A
26 B
R–Y
GR
G–B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
GR–L
LG–R
B
A13 A , A14 B
E
4 A
BM
13
5 A
IJ2
8 B
SRLH
4 B
SRRR
W–B
BR
SFRH
2 B
12
A4 A , A5 B
7 B
SRRH
3 B
SFLR
11
5 B
SFLH
MT
10 A
R–B
IJ2
W–R
2 B
SRLR
ABS ACTUATOR
EA
SFRR
1 B
W–R
6 A
M
EC
SFLH
11 A
G–Y
6 B
BS
SFLR
12 A
L–B
IJ2
LG–B
W–L
W–R
W–B
2 A
1 A
SRRH
TS
G–Y
LG–B
5
E1
SRRR
21 B
TC
W–L
SRLH
15 B
D/G
W–R
W–B
SRLR
14 B
R+
ABS ECU
IJ2
R–W
SR
8 B
R–G
MR
24 B
R–B
1 A
1 B
SFRR
3 A
SFRH
MT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
10A
GAUGE
15A
ECU–IG
9 1J
7 1C
W
R–L
2 1D
15A
STOP
D
2
S4
STOP LIGHT SW
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
D
7
A7
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
2
1
R
G
G–W
1
B–R
C12
ABS WARNING
LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
A6
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
2
1
4 1R
R–L
4
5 1R
1
IJ2
6
IJ2
G–W
IF1
G–B
12
A A
IB1
G
9
1
2
A19
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR LH
IF
B
9 A
RL–
FR+
FR–
RR+
RR–
10 B
23 B
2
B
9 B
R
A
3 A
FL–
W
RL+
22 B
3 IB1
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 A
FL+
IK1
1
IK1
B
STP
G
12 B
W–B
GND
25 B
W
5 B
IG1
W–B
GND
13 B
R
WA
G–W
G–B
A13 A , A14 B
ABS ECU
11 B
8 A
C B
C
C
G
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W
C
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
G–B
J23 A , J24 B
C
C
1
2
A20
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR RH
ABS
SYSTEM OUTLINE
This system controls the respective brake fluid pressures acting on the disc brake cylinders of the right front wheel, left front
wheel and rear wheels when the brakes are applied in a panic stop so that the wheels do not lock. This results in improved
directional stability and steerability during panic braking.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) Speed sensor signal
The speed of the wheels is detected and input to TERMINALS FL+, FR+, RL+ and RR+ of the ABS ECU.
(2) Stop light SW signal
A signal is input to TERMINAL STP of the ABS ECU when the brake pedal is depressed.
2. SYSTEM OPERATION
During sudden braking the ABS ECU has signals input from each sensor, which controls the current to the solenoid inside
the actuator and lets the hydraulic pressure acting on each wheel cylinder escape to the reservoir. The pump inside the
actuator is also operating at this time and it returns the brake fluid from the reservoir to the master cylinder, thus preventing
locking of the vehicle wheels.
If the ABS ECU judges that the hydraulic pressure acting on the wheel cylinder is insufficient, the current on the solenoid is
controlled and the hydraulic pressure is increased. Holding of the hydraulic pressure is also controlled by the ABS ECU, by
the same method as above. Pressure reduction, holding and increase are repeated to maintain vehicle stability and to
improve steerability during sudden braking.
SERVICE HINTS
A6, A7 ABS SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH, RH
2–1 : Approx. 1.6 kΩ (20°C, 68°F)
A19, A20 ABS SPEED SENSOR REAR LH, RH
2–1 : Approx. 1.6 kΩ (20°C, 68°F)
A14 (B) ABS ECU
(B)13–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
(B) 5–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the brake pedal depressed
(B)12, (B) 25–GROUND :
Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A4
A
28
C12
30
J12
31
A5
B
28
D1
28
J20
31
A6
28
D2
30
J22
A7
28
J2
31
J23
A
31
J3
31
J24
B
31
A13
A
30
A14
B
30
J6
A
31
A19
32
J7
B
31
A20
32
J9
31
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
3
See Page
26
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Radiator Upper Support RH)
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
1R
S4
31
31
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IB1
36
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IG3
38
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
38
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
38
Floor No.2 Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IJ1
IJ2
IK1
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EA
34
Right Radiator Side Support
EC
34
Intake Manifold
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E1
See Page
34
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
MEMO
SRS
NOTICE: When inspecting or repairing the SRS, perform the operation in accordance with the following precautionary
instructions and the procedure and precautions in the Repair Manual for the applicable model year.
Malfunction symptoms of the SRS are difficult to confirm, so the DTCs become the most important source of information
when troubleshooting. When troubleshooting the SRS, always inspect the DTCs before disconnecting the battery.
Work must be started after 90 seconds from when the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the
negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back–up power source so that if work is started within 90 seconds from
disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may be deployed.)
When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the memory of the clock and audio system will be
canceled. So before starting work, make a record of the contents memorized in the audio memory system. When work is
finished, reset the audio systems as they were before and adjust the clock. To avoid erasing the memory in each
memory system, never use a back–up power supply from outside the vehicle.
Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor if shocks are likely to be applied to the sensor during repairs.
Do not expose the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, seat belt pretensioner, center airbag sensor
assembly or front airbag sensor assembly directly to hot air or flames.
Even in cases of a minor collision where the SRS does not deploy, the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag
assembly, seat belt pretensioner, center airbag sensor assembly and front airbag sensor assembly should be inspected.
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
Never disassemble and repair the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, seat belt pretensioner, center
airbag sensor assembly or front airbag sensor assembly in order to reuse it.
If the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, seat belt pretensioner, center airbag sensor assembly or
front airbag sensor assembly has been dropped, or if there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or
connector, replace them with new ones.
Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V minimum) for troubleshooting the system’s electrical circuits.
Information labels are attached to the periphery of the SRS components. Follow the instructions on the notices.
After work on the SRS is completed, perform the SRS warning light check.
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precaution in the IN section of the Repair
Manual.
SRS
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
5A
IGN
15A
CIG
4 1N
10A
ECU–B
2 1N
7 2J
A9
AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT LH
W–R
A10
AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT RH
3
1W
2
1G
E7
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE
F/PS
A
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
2
2 IA1
L
1 IA1
8 IG1
B–W
W–R
BR–W
1
12
B
L
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
2
BR
1
B
GR
B–O
A
A
1
II1
2
II1
6 B
+SL
ACC
L
15 B
–SL
B–W
26 B
IG2
BR–W
W–R
5 B
BR
A
20 B
9 B
4 B
–SR
+SR
GSW
C4 A , C5 B , C6 C
E1
E2
D–
P+
P–
27 B
28 B
14 B
13 B
10 B
11 B
W–B
W–B
Y–B
Y
Y–R
Y–G
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
1 1N
3 1N
1
2
1
2
3 1V
W–B
W–B
7 1J
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
ID
D+
SPIRAL
CABLE
A17
AIRBAG SQUIB
(STEERING
WHEEL PAD)
A16
AIRBAG SQUIB
(FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY)
J8
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–R
AB
TC
11 IG3
3
BR
LG–R
7 IG3
W–R
E1
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
11
LG
5
12
C11
SRS WARNING
LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
LG–R
IE2
A
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
A
B
P–B
B
B–Y
A
3 B
19 B
LA
LG–R
LG
D2
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
2
LG
LG
13
TC
C4 A , C5 B , C6 C
4
TC
E1
3
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
PL–
PR+
5 C
PR–
SIL
12 B
6 C
B B
BR
J6 A ,
C A
BR
W
(SHIELDED)
C
C A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Y
Y–B
Y
C
Y–B
J7 B
W
1 A
BR
PL+
2 A
I1
6 IG3
P13
PRETENSIONER
LH
P14
PRETENSIONER
RH
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
7
BR
2
A
A
A
BR
1
D3
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
2
SIL
1
EC
SRS
SYSTEM OUTLINE
The SRS is a driver and front passenger protection device which has a supplemental role to the seat belts.
When the ignition SW is turned to ACC or ON, current from the CIG fuse flows to TERMINAL (B) 6 of the center airbag
sensor assembly. Only when the ignition SW is on does the current flow from the IGN fuse to TERMINAL (B) 5 of the center
airbag sensor assembly.
If an accident occurs while driving, when the frontal impact exceeds a set level, current from the CIG or IGN fuse flows to
TERMINALS (B) 14, (B) 10, (A) 2 and (C) 5 of the center airbag sensor assembly to TERMINAL 1 of the airbag squibs and
the pretensioners to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINALS (B) 13, (B) 11, (A) 1 and (C) 6 of the center airbag sensor assembly to
TERMINAL (B) 27, (B) 28 or BODY GROUND to GROUND, so that current flows to the front airbag squibs and the
pretensioners and causes them to operate.
The airbag stored inside the steering wheel pad is instantaneously expanded to soften the shock to the driver.
The airbag stored inside the passenger’s instrument panel is instantaneously expanded to soften the shock to the front
passenger.
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
J7
See Page
A9
28
C11
30
B
31
A10
28
D1
28
J8
31
A16
30
D2
30
J9
31
A17
30
D3
30
J20
31
C4
A
30
E7
30
P13
33
C5
B
30
J2
31
P14
33
C6
C
30
J6
A
31
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1G
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1N
1V
1W
2J
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IA1
36
Cowl Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE2
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
38
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
38
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Cowl Side Panel RH)
IG1
IG3
II1
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EC
34
Intake Manifold
ID
36
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I1
See Page
38
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
MEMO
SHIFT LOCK
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
15A
CIG
15A
ECU–IG
8 1D
7 1C
W
1 1T
15A
STOP
P–L
B–R
2
S4
STOP LIGHT
SW
A
C
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
1
G–W
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
B–R
1
3
2 1H
G–W
P–L
4 1R
ACC
S3
SHIFT LOCK ECU
6
IG
SHIFT LOCK
CONTROL SW
STP
P1
P
P2
SLS–
G–R
3
G
2
G–W
1
L
SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID
SLS+
KLS+
E
5
W–B
L–B
4
L–B
5 IE1
A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
K1
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
W–B
A
A
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
8
1J
7
1J
W–B
W–B
1
A
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
IE
L–R
2
1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
When the ignition SW is turned to ACC position the current from the CIG fuse flows to TERMINAL 1 of the shift lock ECU, in
the ON position, the current from the ECU–IG fuse flows to TERMINAL 3 of the ECU.
1. SHIFT LOCK MECHANISM
With the ignition SW on, when a signal that the brake pedal is depressed (Stop light SW on) and a signal that the shift lever
is put in P position (Continuity between P1 and P of the shift lock control SW) is input to the shift lock ECU, the ECU
operates and current flows from TERMINAL 3 of the ECU to TERMINAL SLS+ of the shift lock solenoid to solenoid to
TERMINAL SLS– to TERMINAL 5 of the ECU to GROUND. This causes the shift lock solenoid to turn on (Plate stopper
disengages) and the shift lever can shift into position other than the P.
2. KEY INTERLOCK MECHANISM
With the ignition SW ON or ACC position, when the shift lever is put in P position (No continuity between P2 and P of shift
lock control SW), the current flowing from TERMINAL 4 of the shift lock ECU to the key interlock solenoid is cut off. This
causes the key interlock solenoid to turn off (Lock lever disengages from LOCK position) and the ignition key can be turned
from ACC to LOCK position.
SERVICE HINTS
S3 SHIFT LOCK ECU
1–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
3–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
5–GROUND : Always continuity
6–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the brake pedal depressed
S4 STOP LIGHT SW
2–1 : Closed with the brake pedal depressed
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
J4
31
J9
31
S3
31
J5
31
J16
31
S4
31
J6
31
K1
31
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1C
1D
1H
1J
1R
1T
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IE1
See Page
36
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
36
Left Kick Panel
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
HORN
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
10A
HORN
1
5
2
3
10 2K
1 2F
G–B
G–W
HORN
RELAY
C
G–W
C
G–B
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
6
G–W
C14
HORN SW
[COMB. SW]
1
1
H3
HORN
(HIGH)
H4
HORN
(LOW)
SERVICE HINTS
HORN RELAY
5–3 : Closed with the horn SW on
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
C14
30
H4
28
H3
28
J1
31
Code
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
2F
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2K
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
See Page
CIGARETTE LIGHTER AND CLOCK
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
15A
CIG
7. 5A
PANEL
1 1T
5 1D
12 2J
G
R
6 1J
7. 5A
DOME
P–L
1 1W
A A
J28 A , J29 B
R–Y
P–L
A B
8 1G
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
A
D5
DIODE
(DOME)
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
R
A
D
B
E
A
G
J16 A , J17 B
R
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C7
CIGARETTE
LIGHTER
1
P–L
2
3
1
C9
CLOCK
2
W–B
W–B
4
A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
A
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
IE
SERVICE HINTS
C7 CIGARETTE LIGHTER
2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
1–GROUND : Always continuity
C9 CLOCK
4–GROUND :
1–GROUND :
2–GROUND :
3–GROUND :
Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
Always approx. 12 volts
Always continuity
Approx. 12 volts with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
C7
30
J5
C9
30
D5
30
J16
A
31
J4
31
J17
B
31
J9
Code
J28
A
31
31
J29
B
31
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1D
1G
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1T
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2J
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
36
Left Kick Panel
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
See Page
31
KEY REMINDER AND SEAT BELT WARNING
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
25A
DOOR
10A
GAUGE
R–L
2
1D
1 1D
7 C
C10 A , C12 C
C B
SEAT BELT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
4 A
1 1W
13 A
1
I12 A
INTEGRATION RELAY
9
L–W
R–W
A A
3 1T
12 2J
L–W
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7
R
D
J31 A , J32 B
D
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
7. 5A
DOME
5
6
8
5 1M
7 1S
4 1S
R–Y
1
1
L–B
10
R–G
BUZZER
1
U1
UNLOCK
WARNING SW
W–B
2
3 1M
B5
BUCKLE
SW LH
D7
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
2
A
W–B
W–B
7 1J
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
A
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BK
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current always flows to TERMINAL 1 of the integration relay through the DOME fuse.
1. SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
When the ignition SW is turned on, current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 7 of the integration relay. At the same
time, current flows to TERMINAL 9 of the relay from the GAUGE fuse through the seat belt warning light. This current
activates the relay and the current flowing through the warning light flows from TERMINAL 9 of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to
GROUND, causing the warning light to light up. A buckle SW off signal is input to TERMINAL 8 of the relay to TERMINAL 10
to GROUND, causing the warning light to light up. A buckle SW off signal is input to TERMINAL 8 of the relay, the current
flowing to TERMINAL 1 of the relay flows from TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and the seat belt warning buzzer sounds for
approx. 6 seconds. However, if the seat belt is put on during this period (While the buzzer is sounding), signal input to
TERMINAL 8 of the relay stops and the current flow from TERMINAL 1 of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND is cut,
causing the buzzer to stop.
2. KEY REMINDER SYSTEM
With the ignition key inserted in the key cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), the ignition SW still off and driver’s door open
(Door courtesy SW on), when a signal is input to TERMINAL 6 of the integration relay, the relay operates, current flows from
TERMINAL 1 of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and key reminder buzzer sounds.
SERVICE HINTS
B5 BUCKLE SW LH
1–2 : Closed with driver’s seat belt in use
D7 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH
1–GROUND : Closed with front LH door open
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
1–2 : Closed with ignition key in cylinder
I12 (A) INTEGRATION RELAY
10–GROUND : Always continuity
6–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door open
5–GROUND : Continuity with the ignition key in cylinder
8–GROUND : Continuity with the driver’s seat belt in use
1–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(A)13–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
B5
C10
C12
32
A
30
C
30
D7
Code
I12
See Page
A
J3
J9
32
J31
A
30
Code
J32
1D
See Page
J34
32
31
U1
31
31
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
22
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1T
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2J
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1M
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
BK
40
Under the Left Center Pillar
31
31
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
B
POWER OUTLET
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
15A
POWER–
OUTLET
V
5 1J
2
P4
POWER
OUTLET
W–B
1
4 1V
W–B
3 1V
ID
SERVICE HINTS
P4 POWER OUTLET
2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
1–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
P4
Code
See Page
31
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1J
1V
See Page
22
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
ID
See Page
36
Ground Points Location
Cowl Side Panel LH
Code
See Page
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
* 1 : W/ MIRROR HEATER
* 2 : W/O MIRROR HEATER
15A
CIG
P–L
1 1T
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
P–L
A
R5
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
9
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
M
IL1
4 A
3 B
2 A
1 B
M
M
R13 A , B
R14 A , B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH
OPERATION SW
SELECT SW
RIGHT/
DOWN
E
6
10
W–B
A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
LG–R
LG–B
BR–R
14
15
IL1
LG–R
M
3 A (*1)
2 B (*2)
IL1
LG–B
2 A
1 B
16
BR–R
LG–R
4 A
3 B
LG–R
15 ID1
BR–Y
14 ID1
BR–W
16 ID1
BR–Y
C
M+
W–B
7
LG–B
VR
1
BR–Y
VL
8
BR–R
HR
5
BR–W
HL
MV
LG–R
MH
LEFT/
UP
DOWN
UP
LEFT
RIGHT
B
3 A (* 1)
2 B (* 2)
IE
SERVICE HINTS
R5 REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
9–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
6–10 : Continuity with the operation SW at UP or LEFT position
9–6 : Continuity with the operation SW at DOWN or RIGHT position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
J3
31
J4
31
J5
31
Code
See Page
R5
R13
31
A
33
B
33
Code
R14
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1T
See Page
22
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
ID1
36
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IL1
38
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
IE
See Page
36
Ground Points Location
Left Kick Panel
See Page
A
33
B
33
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER AND MIRROR HEATER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
1
10A
HEATER
40A
DEF
10A
MIRROR–
HEATER
2
1
5
NOISE
FILTER
2
DEFOGGER
RELAY
L–B
5 1T
8
IB1
4 1D
5 ID1
5
7 1J
W–B
Y–G
1 1L
B–Y
13 1J
B–Y
12 1J
3
B
3 1R
L–B
1
2
IL1
R14
MIRROR HEATER RH
[REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR RH]
W–B
B–Y
A
J35
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
R13
MIRROR HEATER LH
[REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR LH]
W–B
B–Y
J30
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J33
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
L–B
1
B
5
5
D
A
A
5
A
A
W–B
W–B
4
IG
1
1
20
IL1
W–B
20 ID1
TIMER
CIRCUIT
W–B
7 1G
E
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
3 1V
W–B
R4
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
N2
NOISE FILTER
(REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER)
W–B
W–B
3
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
IF
W–B
ID
II
SERVICE HINTS
DEFOGGER RELAY
5–3 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position and the rear window defogger SW on
R4 REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SW
4–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
3–GROUND : Always continuity
R13, R14 MIRROR HEATER LH, RH [REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR LH, RH]
1–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the rear window defogger SW on
5–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
J9
31
J35
32
R13
33
J30
31
N2
33
R14
33
J33
32
R4
31
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
1T
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
1J
1L
1R
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IB1
36
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
ID1
36
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IL1
38
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
ID
36
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
II
36
Right Kick Panel
RADIO AND PLAYER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
20A
RADIO
NO. 1
7. 5A
RAD–NO. 2
3 1H
GR
L–Y
11 2K
5 1W
L–Y
6 1G
B
A
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
GR
A
L–Y
B
4 A
3 A
BU +B
ACC +B
R2 B , R3 A
2
BR
F15
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
1
2
F16
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
W
9 IC1
3 IC1
10 IC1
4 IC1
1
2
R11
REAR SPEAKER
LH
W
R
L
IL1
RR–
3 B
R
1
RR+
1 B
Y
IL1
RL–
6 B
Y
L
LG
9
RL+
2 B
B
FR–
5 A
LG
V
1 ID1
V
9 ID1
1
IG
FR+
1 A
B
FL–
6 A
P
BR
FL+
2 A
P
GND
7 A
RADIO AND PLAYER
1
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
RH
SERVICE HINTS
R3 (A) RADIO AND PLAYER
(A) 4–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 3–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
(A) 7–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
F15
32
R2
F16
32
R3
J16
31
R11
See Page
B
31
A
31
33
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1G
22
1H
22
1W
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2K
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IC1
36
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
ID1
36
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IL1
38
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
IG
See Page
36
Ground Points Location
Instrument Panel Brace RH
Code
R12
See Page
33
COMBINATION METER
10A
GAUGE
1 1J
7. 5A
DOME
TO CRUISE
CONTROL ECU
TO ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
8
1G
R–Y
2 1D
1
1W
12 2J
R
D
R–L
V–W
V–W
D5
DIODE
(DOME)
R
2
B
E
3
IF1
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
V–W
R
F
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
V–W
D
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
F
R–L
R–L
1
C10 A , C11 B , C12 C
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
WATER TEMP.
3 IH1
6 IH1
2 C
G–R
Y–G
P
P
G–R
BR
Y–G
V1
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION METER)
SE
IF1
TO ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE
2
TO DOOR
COURTESY SW
B–O
E7
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE
1 A
10
G–W
2
FUEL
2 A
BR
DOOR
L
2 IH1
SI
FROM ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE
IG+
1
IG
1
W3
WATER
TEMP.
SENDER
BR
BR
R–L
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
D
R–L
8
FUELW
10 B
7 IH1
3
5 IG1
6 C
IF1
4 IH1
Y–R
IF1
Y–R
R–L
9
15 B
L
6
2 IG2
11 B
R–W
8 C
B–O
5 C
14 B
SPEEDOMETER
TRIP METER
ODOMETER
TACHOMETER
FUEL
3 B
BR
R–L
Y–R
6 B
COMBINATION METER
G–W
FUEL
7 C
EC
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
5A
STARTER
B–W
3 1J
C B
J6 A ,
B–W
5
P
B A
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
N
6
6 IE1
10
IG2
GR
J7 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
GR
11
IG2
B–W
B–O
B
GR
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
C10 A , C11 B , C12 C
COMBINATION METER
G–O
TO O/D
MAIN SW
R–W
B
B
R–W
B
R–W
Y–G
W1
WASHER LEVEL
WARNING SW
TO ABS ECU
TO INTEGRATION
RELAY
2
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
P–L
O
IE2
IC2
IJ2
1
O/D OFF
BULB
CHECK
RELAY
BRAKE
Y–G
3
5
3
TO CRUISE
CONTROL ECU
IF1
12 A
1
7
B1
BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL WARNING SW
IE1
R–W
17
P–L
IE2
7 B
R–W
3 A
O
5
5 IH1
Y–B
REAR LIGHTS
WASHER LEVEL
11 C
P–L
4 C
R–L
ABS
SEAT BELT
4 A
R–W
OIL
CRUISE
10 C
Y–B
5 B
2 B
2
EB
TO LIGHT
FAILURE
SENSOR
P3
PARKING
BRAKE SW
1
W–B
O1
OIL PRESSURE
SW
W–B
1
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
COMBINATION METER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
5A
IGN
FROM A/T INDICATOR LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
8 1T
R
B–R
O
Y
G
10 A
7 A
11 A
6 A
13 C
C10 A , C11 B , C12 C
B
COMBINATION METER
12 C
Y
W–B
D
B
R6
RHEOSTAT
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
16 B
L
2
P
4 B
ILLUMINATION
R–B
8 A
D
G–W
9 A
N
B–R
13 A
R
G–Y
1 C
CHARGE
G–B
G
1 B
D
2
ILL
TO GENERATOR
E
A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
IE
T
1
G
3
W–B
TURN RH
TURN LH
FROM HAZARD SW OR
TURN SIGNAL SW
[COMB. SW]
A
W–B
A
W–B
G
W–B
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
7. 5A
PANEL
10A
ECU–B
5 1D
7 2J
G
W–R
R–L
3
FROM HEADLIGHT LH, RH
IE1
A
G
A
A
3 1W
R–L
J28
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
W–R
2 1G
W–B
W–B
G
COMBINATION METER
C10 A , C11 B , C12 C
9 B
LG
SRS
13 B
TO CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
G
8 B
HIGH BEAM
12 B
COMBINATION METER
SERVICE HINTS
B1 BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SW
1–2 : Closed with the float down
C10 (A), C11 (B), C12 (C) COMBINATION METER
(B) 2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ST position and the shift lever at P or N position
(A) 13, (C) 7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
(B)11, (B) 12–GROUND: Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 2, (B) 9, (B) 16, (C) 5–GROUND : Always continuity
O1 OIL PRESSURE SW
1–GROUND : Closed with the oil pressure above approx. 19.6 kpa (2.8 psi, 0.2 kgf/cm2)
P3 PARKING BRAKE SW
1–GROUND : Closed with the parking brake lever pulled up
W3 WATER TEMP. SENDER
1–GROUND : Approx. 160–240 Ω (50°C, 122°F)
Approx. 17.1–21.2 Ω (120°C, 248°F)
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
B1
Code
28
J6
J7
See Page
Code
See Page
A
31
O1
29
B
C10
A
30
31
P1
29
C11
B
30
J9
31
P3
31
C
C12
30
J15
31
R6
31
D5
30
J16
31
V1
29
E7
30
J19
31
W1
29
J1
31
J22
31
W3
29
J3
31
J24
31
J4
31
J28
31
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1D
1G
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1T
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2J
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IC2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
36
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
36
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
38
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IH1
38
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IJ2
38
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IE1
IE2
IF1
IG1
IG2
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
34
Intake Manifold
IE
36
Left Kick Panel
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IG
36
Instrument Panel Brace RH
RADIATOR FAN AND CONDENSER FAN
ACC
2 AM1
1
1
IG1 4
30A
RDI
30A
CDS
2
B–Y
2
1
FAN
NO. 1
RELAY
1 1K
2
40A
AM1
15A
ECU–IG
1 2C
2
3
2 2F
1 2G
7 2G
2 2C
B–R
2 1K
4
L
W
I10
IGNITION SW
2 2H
M
G–W
W–B
B–R
4 2F
B–R
2 2B
B–R
E3
1 F
2 F
1 D
3
3
2
2
FAN
NO. 3
RELAY
1
5
W–R
W–B
W4
WATER TEMP.
SW NO. 1
W–B
1
FL MAIN
3. 0W
2 EA1
W–B
BATTERY
E2
W–B
W–B
B–G
F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
EB
W–B
2
1
3
4
1
5
1
B–R
L–W
2
F 9 A , F12 D ,
1
W–B
1 EA1
1 A
1
3
1
100A
ALT
1
R
G–W
1
FAN NO. 2 RELAY
ENGINE
MAIN
RELAY
1
M
B–W
5
4
2
1
A3
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
2
1
L–W
B–R
6 2K
R1
RADIATOR
FAN MOTOR
A1
A/C CONDENSER
FAN MOTOR
2
1
1
W–B
6 1A
B–R
1 1B
FROM MG CLT
RELAY
L
B–R
G–W
1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
FAN MOTOR OPERATION
With the ignition SW turned on, the current through the ECU–IG fuse flows to the FAN NO.1 relay (Coil side), FAN NO.2 relay
(Coil side). furthermore, the current through the FAN NO.1 relay (Coil side) or the FAN NO.2 relay (Coil side) flows to
TERMINAL 3 of the A/C single pressure SW to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 2 of the water temp. SW no.1 to TERMINAL 1 to
GROUND, causing the FAN NO.1 relay to turn off and the FAN NO.2 relay to turn on.
1. LOW SPEED OPERATION
When the ignition SW is turned on and the A/C system is activated, the A/C condenser fan motor and the radiator fan motor
rotates at low speed.
When the A/C system is activated, the current from MG CLT relay flows to the FAN NO.3 relay (Coil side) to GROUND,
causing the FAN NO.3 relay to turn on. As a result, the current through the CDS fuse flows to TERMINAL 2 of the A/C
condenser fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 3 of the FAN NO.2 relay to TERMINAL 5 to TERMINAL 5 of the FAN
NO.3 relay to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL 2 of the radiator fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND.
2. HIGH SPEED OPERATION
Only when the A/C single pressure SW is turned off or the water temp. SW no.1 is turned off, the A/C condenser fan motor
and the radiator fan motor rotate at high speed.
When the A/C single pressure SW is turned off or the water temp. SW no.1 is turned off. the current from the RDI fuse flows
to the FAN NO.1 relay (Point side) to TERMINAL 2 of the radiator fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND. At the same time,
the current from the CDS fuse flows to TERMINAL 2 of the A/C condenser fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 3 of the
FAN NO.2 relay to TERMINAL 4 to GROUND.
SERVICE HINTS
A3 A/C SINGLE PRESSURE SW
3–2 : Open above approx. 15.5 kgf/cm2 (220 psi, 1520 kpa)
Closed below approx. 12.5 kgf/cm2 (177 psi, 1225 kpa)
W4 WATER TEMP. SW NO.1
2–1 : Open above approx. 95°C (203° F)
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
A1
A3
F9
A
Code
28
F12
28
F14
28
I10
See Page
Code
28
R1
29
F
28
W4
29
30
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
1
See Page
26
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1A
1B
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
24
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1K
2B
2C
2F
2G
2H
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
EA1
See Page
34
See Page
D
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room Main No.3 Wire (Radiator LH)
RADIATOR FAN AND CONDENSER FAN
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
See Page
34
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E2
See Page
34
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
Code
E3
See Page
34
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
MEMO
AIR CONDITIONING
50A HTR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 44)
F13
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
10A
HEATER
2 1W
3 1R
L–B
L–B
1
5 2K
A
L–B
1
5
HTR
RELAY
A
2
1
J30
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
9 2C
3
1
L–B
1
L–W
L–R
L–R
5
MG CLT
RELAY
3
1
W–B
1
4
2
1
L–B
1
1
1
L–B
1
L–B
L–B
L–B
L–B
B–W
B–W
L–Y
L–Y
B–W
TO FAN NO. 3 RELAY
10A A/C
1
1
3
EB1
L–R
L–R
B3
BLOWER RESISTOR
2
M
2
2 EB1
L–R
1 EB2
1
3
B2
BLOWER
MOTOR
6
2
1
4
M1
LO
L–B
8
M2
W–B
5
HI
W–B
L–W
B–W
I6
L–O
B–W
L–B
B–W
1
W–B
W–B
OFF
3
A
1
B4
BLOWER SW
W–B
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
L–B
EB
A
IF
W–B
I3
W–B
H7
HEATER CONTROL SW
L–B
B–W
FACE
B/L
FOOT
F/D
DEF
3
GND
FACE
B/L
FOOT
F/D
DEF
1
8
7
6
5
4
2
L–B
B–W
7
IJ2
L–Y
L–O
B–L
L–R
L
R–B
L–R
L–W
L–Y
W–B
L–Y
D
L–R
D
D
L–R
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
1
2
3
4
5
FACE
B/L
FOOT
F/D
DEF
R–B
A
R–B
M
L–R
R–B
2
5
R–W
1
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
B
L–B
6 IG
OFF
W–B
7 GND
ON
A15
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
A12
A/C SW
AIR CONDITIONING
L–B
B–W
B–W
1
4
A2
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
A3
A/C DUAL
PRESSURE SW
4
2
BR
G
W–L
1
L–Y
IJ2
10
IJ2
BR
9
W–L
IJ2
G
2
B
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
B
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
R–B
2
BR
B
L–W
R–B
B
A11
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
L–R
BR
10 IG3
6 IG3
BR
3 IG2
W–L
1 IG2
L–Y
R–B
1 IG1
G
B
R–W
A
LOCK
10 A
A/CS
21 A
10 D
MGC
PRS
10 B
THR
9 B
E2
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
18 C
LOCK IN
A
BR
15 A
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C , E7 D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
EC
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current always flows from the HTR fuse to TERMINAL 1 of the HTR relay. When the ignition SW is turned on, the current
from the HEATER fuse flows to TERMINAL 6 of the air vent mode control servo motor, and to the MG CLT relay (Coil side) to
TERMINAL (A) 21 of the engine control module, and to TERMINAL 1 of the A/C dual pressure SW to TERMINAL 4 to
TERMINAL (D) 10 of the engine control module, and to the HTR relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL 3 of the blower SW.
1. AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR OPERATION
When the damper is in FACE position and B/L mode on the heater control SW is selected, current flows from TERMINAL 7
of the heater control SW to TERMINAL 2 of the air vent mode control serve motor so that a signal that the ground circuit is
activated is input into TERMINAL B of the control circuit inside the air vent mode control servo motor. Simultaneously, a
signal that the ground circuit is not activated is input into TERMINAL A of the control circuit inside the servo motor. These two
signals activate the control circuit so that current flows from the HEATER fuse to the servo motor, causing the servo motor to
operate and the damper to move to B/L position. When the damper reaches B/L position. A ground cut signal is input into
TERMINAL B of the control circuit, the control circuit operates, the servo motor stops rotating and the damper stops at B/L.
When another mode position is selected, input of signals into TERMINAL A and TERMINAL B of the control circuit that
ground is made or not (as explained above) activates the control circuit and moves the serve motor to the desired position.
2. AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
When the blower SW is on, current flows from the HEATER fuse to the HTR relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL 3 of the blower
SW to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND, activating the HTR relay. This causes current to flow from the HTR fuse to the HTR relay
(Point side) to A/C fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the A/C SW. If the A/C SW is turned on at this time, a signal is input into the
engine control module. This activates the engine control module and MG CLT relay so that current flows from the HEATER
fuse to the MG CLT relay (Point side) to A/C magnetic clutch. Causing The compressor to operate.
When blower SW is on and heater control SW is at DEF position, it causes A/C to run whether A/C SW is on or not.
SERVICE HINTS
HTR RELAY
1–2 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position and the blower SW on
MG CLT RELAY
5–3 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position,
the blower SW on and the A/C SW on or the heater control SW at DEF position
A3 A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
1–4 : Open with pressure less than approx. 2.0 kgf/cm2 (28 psi, 196 kpa) or above approx. 32 kgf/cm2 (455 psi, 3138 kpa)
B3 BLOWER RESISTOR
2–1 : Approx. 1.64 Ω
2–3 : Approx. 3.24 Ω
2–6 : Approx. 0.47 Ω
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
A2
28
Code
See Page
B4
30
Code
See Page
J7
31
A3
28
E4
A
30
J9
31
A11
30
E5
B
30
J12
31
A12
30
E6
C
30
J20
31
A15
30
E7
D
30
J30
31
B2
30
F13
28
B3
30
H7
30
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
1
See Page
26
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
AIR CONDITIONING
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1R
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2C
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2K
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1W
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
EB1
EB2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
34
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
No 2)
38
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
38
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IG1
IG2
IG3
IJ2
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
34
Intake Manifold
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I3
See Page
38
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
I6
See Page
38
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
MEMO
I GROUND POINT
W–B
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT AND PARKING
LIGHT LH
E1
W–B
RADIATOR FAN
MOTOR
W–B
WASHER LEVEL
WARNING SW
W–B
WATER TEMP. SW
NO. 1
W–B
E2
W–B
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT AND PARKING
LIGHT RH
W–B
E2
W–B
E2
2
EA1
W–B
W–B
E2
1
FAN NO. 3 RELAY
1
HTR RELAY
1
W–B
E2
W–B
FAN NO. 2 RELAY
W–B
W–B
E2
W–B
W–B
W–B
E2
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
EFI RELAY
W–B
10
2J
4
2F
W–B
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
3
W–B
5 2C
W–B
W–B
EB
EA
W–B
ABS SOL RELAY
ABS ACTUATOR
COMBINATION
METER
(ET)
3
IH1
BR
3
IG1
BR
(E04)
BR
(E01)
W–B
IDLE AIR
CONTROL VALVE
BR
(E02)
BR
BR
IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER NO. 1
(E03)
A
IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER NO. 2
A
BR
A
A
BR
BR
W–B
(E05)
BR
(E1)
J18
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE
ENGINE
CONTROL
MODULE
BR
BR
EC
BR
EC
A
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
BR
A
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
BR
C
A
B
B
BR
6
IG3
BR
C
A
B
B
BR
10
IJ2
A
BR
I4
BR
12
IG2
BR
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
BR
J20
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
(SG)
J6 A ,
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
BR
J7 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
RADIO AND PLAYER
BR
BR
IG
6
BB1
W–B
B2
IJ
W–B
W–B
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR RH
BL
(ES)
COMBINATION
METER
I GROUND POINT
CRUISE CONTROL
ECU
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
(CG)
W–B
A
B
A
A
W–B
CRUISE CONTROL
ACTUATOR
W–B
A
B
A
A
W–B
CRUISE CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
A
A
W–B
LIGHT CONTROL AND
DIMMER SW
[COMB. SW]
A
A
W–B
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
A
A
J6 A ,
W–B
W–B
UNLOCK WARNING SW
J7 B
W–B
(E1) CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
A
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
FRONT LH
W–B
A
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
W–B
A
8 1J
3 1M
1 1N
POWER RELAY
J33
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
W–B
POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW
INTEGRATION RELAY
NOISE FILTER
NOISE FILTER
MIRROR HEATER LH
[REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH]
W–B
7 1J
A
W–B
W–B
A
W–B
W–B
9
2K
W–B
W–B
W–B
3
1N
A
W–B
4
1V
I3
W–B
W–B
3 1V
W–B
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
HEATER CONTROL SW
AIR VENT MODE
CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
BLOWER RESISTOR
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
BLOWER SW
A
W–B
W–B
W–B
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
WARNING SW
W–B
POWER OUTLET
(E2)
ST RELAY
W–B
7 1G
W–B
WIPER AND WASHER
SW [COMB. SW]
W–B
20 ID1
CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
A
A
W–B
ID
IH
IF
(GND)
ABS ECU
(GND)
O/D MAIN SW
SHIFT LOCK ECU
(–)
COMBINATION
METER
(EP)
CLOCK
GLOVE BOX LIGHT
AND SW
RHEOSTAT
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
A
J35
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
A
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
FRONT RH
A
W–B
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
W–B
MIRROR HEATER RH
[REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH]
A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
20
IL1
W–B
W–B
A
W–B
IE
HIGH MOUNTED
STOP LIGHT
II
A
W–B
A
W–B
B5
W–B
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT RH
W–B
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT LH
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
W–B
BUCKLE SW LH
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
W–B
B6
W–B
B5
A
W–B
W–B
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
B6
A
W–B
A
W–B
GAS TEMP. SENSOR 1
W–B
LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR
W–B
J34
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B5
B6
BM
BK
6
BA1
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR LH
I GROUND POINT
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
J4
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
31
J9
31
J33
32
J6
A
31
J18
31
J34
32
J7
B
31
J20
31
J35
32
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
See Page
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
1
26
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
3
26
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Radiater Upper support RH)
,,, : JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
1G
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
24
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
24
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1M
1N
1V
2C
2F
2J
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EA1
34
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room Main No.3 Wire (Radiator LH)
ID1
36
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
38
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
IH1
38
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IJ2
38
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IL1
38
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BA1
40
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BB1
40
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
IG1
IG2
IG3
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EA
34
Right Radiator Side Support
EB
34
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
34
Intake Manifold
ID
36
Cowl Side Panel LH
IE
36
Left Kick Panel
IF
36
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IG
36
Instrument Panel Brace RH
IH
36
Cowl Side Panel RH
36
Right Kick Panel
BK
40
Under the Left Center Pillar
BL
40
Under the Right Center Pillar
BM
40
Back Panel Center
II
IJ
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E1
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
34
Engine Room Main Wire
I3
38
Cowl Wire
I4
38
Engine Wire
E2
Code
B2
B5
B6
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
40
Floor No.2 Wire
40
Floor Wire
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
J
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Instrument Panel J/B (See Page 22)
Fuse
5A
IGN
System
Page
Charging
Combination Meter
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
Engine Control
52
138
102
54
SRS
117
138
102
54
48
5A
STARTER
Combination Meter
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
Engine Control
Starting and Ignition
7.5A
OBD
Engine Control
54
7.5A
PANEL
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
Combination Meter
Illumination
126
138
80
7.5A
RAD–NO.2
Radio and Player
136
7.5A
TURN
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light
72
ABS
Back–Up Light
Charging
Combination Meter
112
88
52
138
Cruise Control
Door Lock Control
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
Engine Control
108
98
102
54
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning
Light Auto Turn Off
Power Window
Stop Light
128
68
94
74
Taillight
84
10A
GAUGE
10A
HEATER
Air Conditioning
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
148
134
10A
MIRROR–HEATER
Engine Control
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
54
134
10A
TAIL
Engine Control
Taillight
54
84
CIG
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
Remote Control Mirror
Shift Lock
SRS
126
132
122
117
ECU–IG
ABS
Cruise Control
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
Shift Lock
112
108
144
122
15A
15A
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
J
Fuse
15A
15A
25A
POWER–OUTLET
STOP
DOOR
System
Page
Power Outlet
130
ABS
Cruise Control
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
Engine Control
112
108
102
54
Shift Lock
Stop Light
122
74
Door Lock Control
Interior Light
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning
Light Auto Turn Off
98
76
128
68
Power Window
94
25A
WIPER
Wiper and Washer
90
30A
POWER
Door Lock Control
Power Window
98
94
40A
AM1
Charging
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
52
144
40A
DEF
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
134
Engine Room J/B No.2 (See Page 24)
Fuse
5A
7.5A
ALT–S
DOME
System
Page
Charging
52
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
Combination Meter
Interior Light
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning
126
138
76
128
Light Auto Turn Off
68
10A
ECU–B
Combination Meter
SRS
66
68
10A
HAZARD
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light
48
10A
HORN
Horn
52
15A
HEAD (LH)
Headlight
144
15A
HEAD (RH)
Headlight
144
20A
EFI
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
Engine Control
102
54
20A
RADIO NO.1
Radio and Player
48
30A
AM2
Charging
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
Engine Control
Starting and Ignition
136
102
54
66
30A
CDS
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
66
30A
RDI
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
138
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
J POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Fuse
40A
MAIN
System
Headlight
Light Auto Turn Off
Starting and Ignition
Page
124
117
72
Engine Room R/B No.1 (See Page 26)
Fuse
10A
A/C
System
Air Conditioning
Page
148
Engine Room R/B No.3 (See Page 26)
Fuse
60A
FL ABS
System
ABS
Page
112
Fusible Link Block (F8 on See Page 27)
Fuse
50A
100A
HTR
ALT
System
Page
Air Conditioning
148
Charging
Illumination
Light Auto Turn Off
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
52
80
68
144
Taillight
84
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
MEMO
K CONNECTOR LIST
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
GRAY
GRAY
BLACK
GRAY
BLACK
1
1 2
3 4
2
2
1
4
1
3
3
1 2 3 4
2
4
5 6 7 8
5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
GRAY
GRAY
DARK GRAY
YELLOW
YELLOW
1
1
2
2
A12
1
2
3
4
1
A13
2
1
A14
12345
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
7 8 9 10 11 12
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
A16
A17
A18
YELLOW
BLACK
2
1 2
A15
1 2 3 4 5 6
YELLOW
A11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
A19
A20
B1
GRAY
1 2
1 2
1
2 1
2
B2
B3
2 1
B4
1
B5
2
C1
DARK GRAY
1
1
2
3
2
4
5
1
2 3
4
5
6 7 8
C2
C3
C4
C5
DARK GRAY
BLACK
YELLOW
YELLOW
1 2
1 2 3 4
A
1 2
1 2
6
B
1 2 3
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
A B
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
K
C6
C7
C8
YELLOW
C9
C10
BLACK
BLUE
1
A
1
2
B
2
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 101112
C11
C12
BROWN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
C13
C14
BLACK
BLACK
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
C15
C16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
C17
1 2 3
3
4 5 6 7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
9 10 1112131415 16 17
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1 2
2
4
D1
D2
BLACK
DARK GRAY
5 6
18
19
7 8 9
12 13 14
10 11 20
15
17 16
16 17 21 22 23
15 14
13 12 11 10 9 8 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
D3
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
D4
D5
D6
BLACK
BLACK
ORANGE
1 2
1 2
1 2 3
D7
1
K CONNECTOR LIST
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
D13
D14
BLACK
1
1
1
2
345 6
1
1
2
3
1
2
3
1 2 3 4
D15
D16
D17
E1
E2
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3
1
E3
2
E4
E5
E6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
GREEN
1 2
E7
F1
F2
F3
F4
DARK GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
BLACK
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3
1 2 3
1 2 3
1 2 3
7 8 9 10 11 12
4 5
F5
F6
F7
F8
BLACK
BLUE
GRAY
GREEN
F9
1
1 2
1 2 3
1
F10
1
2
F11
2
F12
F13
F14
ORANGE
(See Page 27)
1
1
1
1
2
K
F15
F16
BLUE
BLUE
F17
G1
G2
G3
BLACK
BLACK
1
1 2
1 2
1
1 2
3 4
2
1
3
2
H1
H2
H3
H4
H5
H6
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
DARK GRAY
1
1
1
2
3
2
H7
1
5 6 7 8 9 10
4
2
I2
I3
I4
GRAY
BLACK
BROWN
1 2 3
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
I6
I7
I8
BROWN
GRAY
BLACK
12
12
12
1 2
I12
12
I9
I13
I10
1 2
J1
ORANGE
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
J2
BLACK
J3
J4
BLACK
ORANGE
A A A
B B
CCCDD DB
1
2
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
A A A
B B
CCCDDDB
2
3
I1
I5
1 2 3 4
1
GRAY
GRAY
I11
3 4
1 2
3
H8
12
3
456 7 8
1
J5
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
J6
GRAY
A A A A A
B B B B
CC C D D DE E E F F F F
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
A A A A A A
B B B C C C
J7
J8
GRAY
BLACK
A A A A
A A A A A A
B B B C C C
J9
A
A
J10
J11
BLACK
BLACK
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
D D D E E E
D D D E E E
A
A
A
A
K CONNECTOR LIST
J12
J13
J14
J15
BLACK
BLUE
BLUE
BLACK
A A A
B B
CCCDDDB
J16
A A A
B B
CCCDD DB
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
B B B B B B
B B B B B B
J18
J19
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
BLUE
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
A A A
B B
A A A B B B B B
A B B
C C
A A B DD D C C
D D D E E E
D D D E E E
J20
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
J17
J21
J22
J23
A A A A A
B B B B
CC C DD DE E E F F F F
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
A A B B C C
D D E E F F
J24
J25
J26
J27
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
D D E E F F
D D E E F F
D D E E F F
J28
J29
J30
J31
GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
BLACK
A A B
CC
A A B B B CC
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
A A B B C C
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
D D D E E E
J32
J33
J34
J35
BLACK
A A A
B B
A A A B B B B
A A B B C C
D D D E E E
A
A
A
A
A
A
A A A
B B
A A A B B B B
K
K1
L1
L2
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
1
1
2
L3
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 101112
2
1 2
M1
N1
BLACK
GRAY
1 2 3
1 2
N2
P1
P2
BLACK
L5
GRAY
1
2
1
O1
O2
GRAY
BLUE
1
1 2
3 4
1
GRAY
L4
GRAY
P3
P4
P5
ORANGE
BLACK
P6
1
1
7
5
6
2
8
1
3 4
9 10
P7
P8
12345
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 1011121314
P13
P14
R1
YELLOW
YELLOW
GRAY
1 2
1 2
1 2 3 4 5
P9
P10
P11
P12
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2
R2
R3
2
1 2
3 4 5 6
3 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
1
2
3 4 5 6
2
R6
R5
R4
BLACK
1
1
12345
2
1
R7
R8
R9
R10
1 2
3 4
1 2 3
1 2
3 4
1 2 3
BLACK
1 2
5 6 7
R11
3 4
8 9 10
1 2 3
R12
R13
(w/ Mirror Heater)
1234 5
1 2
1 2
4 5 6
R13
R14
R14
(w/o Mirror Heater)
(w/ Mirror Heater)
(w/o Mirror Heater)
1 2 3
12345
1 2 3
4 5 6
K CONNECTOR LIST
S1
S2
S3
BLACK
1
1 2 3
4 5 6
1
S4
T1
BLUE
BLACK
1 2 3
1
3
T2
U1
1
2
4
V1
V2
W1
BLACK
BLUE
BLACK
1 2 3
1 2
1
3
W2
W3
W4
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
1
1 2
1 2 3
2
2
1
2
MEMO
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Code
Part Name
Part Number
Code
Part Name
A1
A/C Condenser Fan Motor
90980–10928
D4
Diode (Courtesy)
A2
A/C Magnetic Clutch and Lock Sensor
90980–10942
D5
Diode (Dome)
A3
A/C Triple Pressure SW (A/C Dual and
Single Pressure SW)
90980–10943
D6
Diode (Idle–Up)
D7
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
D8
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
D9
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
D10
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
A4
ABS Actuator
90980–11413
A5
ABS Actuator
90980–10891
A6
ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
A7
ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
A8
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
90980–11075
90980–11178
A9
Airbag Sensor Front LH
A10
Airbag Sensor Front RH
A11
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
90980–10825
A12
A/C SW
90980–10631
A13
ABS ECU
90980–11424
A14
ABS ECU
90980–11390
A15
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
90980–11165
A16
Airbag Squib (Front Passenger Airbag
Assembly)
90980–11884
A17
Airbag Squib (Steering Wheel Pad)
90980–10850
A18
Ashtray Illumination
81945–33010
A19
ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
A20
ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
90980–11856
90980–11060
B1
Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
90980–11207
B2
Blower Motor
90980–10903
Part Number
90980–10962
90980–11071
90980–10871
D11
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
D12
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front RH
D13
Door Lock Control SW RH
D14
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Front LH
D15
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Front RH
D16
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Rear LH
D17
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Rear RH
E1
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Solenoid
90980–11156
E2
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Solenoid
90980–11143
E3
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
90980–10737
E4
Engine Control Module
90980–11392
E5
Engine Control Module
90980–11391
E6
Engine Control Module
90980–11390
E7
Engine Control Module
90980–11408
B3
Blower Resistor
90980–10976
B4
Blower SW
90980–10877
B5
Buckle SW LH
90980–10825
F1
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light
LH
C1
Camshaft Position Sensor
90980–10947
F2
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light
RH
90980–11490
90980–11326
90980–11150
90980–11020
C2
Crankshaft Position Sensor
C3
Cruise Control Actuator
90980–11150
F3
Front Wiper Motor
C4
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11869
F4
Fuel Pressure Sensor (Delivery Pipe)
C5
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11872
F5
Fuel Pressure Sensor (Fuel Pipe)
C6
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11867
F6
Fuel Shutoff Valve (Delivery Pipe)
90980–11156
C7
Cigarette Lighter
90980–10760
F7
90980–11038
C8
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
90980–11148
Fuel Shutoff Valve (Fuel Pressure
Regulator)
C9
Clock
90980–11013
F8
Fuel Temp. Sensor (Delivery Pipe)
90980–10737
C10
Combination Meter
90980–11114
C11
Combination Meter
90080–98046
C12
Combination Meter
90980–11115
C13
Combination SW
90980–11594
C14
Combination SW
90980–11616
C15
Combination SW
90980–11672
C16
Cruise Control ECU
90980–11391
C17
Condenser
90980–10860
D1
Data Link Connector 1
90980–11323
D2
Data Link Connector 2
90980–11417
D3
Data Link Connector 3
90980–11665
90980–11599
90980–10845
F9
Fusible Link Block
90980–09566
F10
Fusible Link Block
90980–09567
F11
Fusible Link Block
90980–09566
F12
Fusible Link Block
99141–13006
F13
Fusible Link Block
82620–06010
F14
Fusible Link Block
90980–11579
F15
Front Door Speaker LH
F16
Front Door Speaker RH
F17
Fuel Temp. Sensor and Fuel Shutoff Valve
(Fuel Tank)
90980–10795
G1
Generator
90980–09213
90980–10825
Note: Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply. In case of ordering
a connector or terminal with wire, please confirm in advance if there is supply for it using “Parts Catalog
News” (published by Parts Engineering Administration Dept.).
L
Code
Part Name
Part Number
Code
Part Name
G2
Generator
90980–11349
J23
Junction Connector
G3
Glove Box Light and SW
90980–11098
J24
Junction Connector
H1
Headlight LH
J25
Junction Connector
H2
Headlight RH
J26
Junction Connector
H3
Horn (High)
J27
Junction Connector
H4
Horn (Low)
H5
Hazard SW
H6
H7
90980–11314
90980–10619
Part Number
90980–11661
90980–11542
J28
Junction Connector
90980–10801
J29
Junction Connector
Heated Oxygen Sensor
90980–11028
J30
Junction Connector
Heater Control SW
90980–10799
J31
Junction Connector
H8
High Mounted Stop Light
90980–11148
J32
Junction Connector
I1
Idle Air Control Valve
90980–11145
J33
Junction Connector
90980–10803
I2
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.1
J34
Junction Connector
90980–10976
J35
Junction Connector
90980–10803
K1
Key Interlock Solenoid
90980–10825
L1
License Plate Light LH
L2
License Plate Light RH
L3
Light Failure Sensor
I3
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.2
I4
Injector No.1
I5
Injector No.2
90980–11150
90980–11153
90980–11661
90980–10803
90980–11661
90980–11148
I6
Injector No.3
I7
Injector No.4
I8
Intake Air Temp. Sensor
90980–11163
L4
Luggage Compartment Light
90980–11148
I9
Ignition Key Cylinder Light
90980–10906
L5
Luggage Compartment Light SW
90980–11097
I10
Ignition SW
90980–11615
M1
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
90980–10845
90980–10803
I11
Integration Relay
90980–11107
N1
Noise Filter (Ignition)
90980–10843
I12
Integration Relay
90980–11542
N2
Noise Filter (Rear Window Defogger)
90980–11259
I13
Interior Light
90980–10121
O1
Oil Pressure SW
90980–11363
J1
Junction Connector
90980–10803
O2
Junction Connector
90980–11542
O/D Main SW and A/T Shift Lever
Illumination
90980–10795
J2
J3
Junction Connector
90980–10803
P1
Park/Neutral Position SW,A/T Indicator Light
SW and Back–Up Light SW
90980–11332
J4
Junction Connector
90980–11542
P2
Power Steering Oil Pressure SW
90980–11428
J5
Junction Connector
90980–11502
P3
Parking Brake SW
90980–10871
J6
Junction Connector
P4
Power Outlet
90980–10760
J7
Junction Connector
P5
Power Window Control SW Front RH
90980–10789
J8
Junction Connector
90980–11398
P6
Power Window Control SW Rear LH
J9
Junction Connector
90980–10976
P7
Power Window Control SW Rear RH
J10
Junction Connector
J11
Junction Connector
90980–11661
P8
Power Window Master SW and Door Lock
Control SW LH
J12
Junction Connector
90980–10803
P9
Power Window Motor Front LH
J13
Junction Connector
P10
Power Window Motor Front RH
J14
Junction Connector
P11
Power Window Motor Rear LH
J15
Junction Connector
P12
Power Window Motor Rear RH
J16
Junction Connector
P13
Pretensioner LH
J17
Junction Connector
P14
Pretensioner RH
J18
Junction Connector
R1
Radiator Fan Motor
90980–10928
J19
Junction Connector
R2
Radio and Player
90980–10996
J20
Junction Connector
90980–11539
R3
Radio and Player
90980–10997
J21
Junction Connector
90980–11529
R4
Rear Window Defogger SW
90980–11280
J22
Junction Connector
90980–11502
R5
Remote Control Mirror SW
90980–11450
90980–11661
90980–11661
90980–10803
90980–11661
90980–11542
90980–10631
90980–10807
90980–10860
90980–11862
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Code
Part Name
Part Number
R6
Rheostat
90980–10908
R7
Rear Combination Light LH
90980–10795
R8
Rear Combination Light LH
90980–11001
R9
Rear Combination Light RH
90980–10795
R10
Rear Combination Light RH
90980–11001
R11
Rear Speaker LH
R12
Rear Speaker RH
90980–10558
Remote Control Mirror LH (w/o Mirror
Heater)
90980–10395
Remote Control Mirror RH (w/ Mirror
Heater)
90980–10558
Remote Control Mirror RH (w/o Mirror
Heater)
90980–10395
S1
Starter
90980–09689
S2
Starter
90980–11400
S3
Shift Lock ECU
90980–11488
S4
Stop Light SW
90980–11118
T1
Throttle Position Sensor
90980–11261
T2
Turn Signal Flasher
82751–50010
U1
Unlock Warning SW
90980–10860
V1
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Combination Meter)
90980–11143
V2
VSV (EGR)
90980–11156
W1
Washer Level Warning SW
90980–11068
W2
Washer Motor
90980–10981
W3
Water Temp. Sender
90980–11428
W4
Water Temp. SW No.1
90980–11235
R14
Part Name
Part Number
90980–10860
Remote Control Mirror LH (w/ Mirror Heater)
R13
Code
Note: Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply. In case of ordering
a connector or terminal with wire, please confirm in advance if there is supply for it using “Parts Catalog
News” (published by Parts Engineering Administration Dept.).
L
Code
Part Name
Part Number
Code
Part Name
Part Number
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
[A] : System Title
[B] : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B
= Black
W = White
BR = Brown
L
= Blue
V
SB = Sky Blue
= Violet
R = Red
O = Orange LG = Light Green
P
Y
= Pink
= Yellow
[F] : Junction Block (The number in the circle is the
J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Blocks are shaded to clearly
separate them from other parts.
Example:
GR = Gray
G = Green
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the
second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Example:
,,,,
,,,,
3C indicates
,,,,
that it is inside
,,,,
Junction Block
,,,,
,,,,No.3
,,,,
L–Y
[G] : Indicates related system.
L
(Blue)
[H] : Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness
connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows ( ).
Outside numerals are pin numbers.
Y
(Yellow)
[C] : The position of the parts is the same as shown in
the wiring diagram and wire routing.
[D] : Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female
and male connectors.
Example : Numbered in order
from upper left to
lower right
Numbered in order
from upper right to
lower left
Female
[I]
Male (
)
: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and
connector, etc. when the vehicle model, engine
type, or specification is different.
[J] : Indicates a shielded cable.
Female
Male
The numbering system for the overall wiring
diagram is the same as above
[E] : Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and
only the Relay Block No. is shown to distinguish
it from the J/B.
Example :
[K] : Indicates and located on ground point.
[L] : The same code occuring on the next page
indicates that the wire harness is continuous.
Indicates Relay Block No.1
M
SYSTEMS
LOCATION
SYSTEMS
LOCATION
ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–2
Power Outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12–3
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19–2
Power Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1~19–1
Back–Up Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–4
Power Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–2
Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–4
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18–3
Cigarette Lighter and Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12–4
Radio and Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11–7
Combination Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17–2
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18–2
Cruse Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13–2
Remote Control Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9–3
Door Lock Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11–2
Shift Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12–2
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator . . . . . . . . . . 3–2
SRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14–2
Engine Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2
Starting and Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2
Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2
Stop Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8–4
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16–4
Taillight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8–2
Illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7–2
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–2
Interior Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–3
Wiper and Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9–2
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16–2
Light Auto Turn Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–2
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
SYSTEM INDEX
M
1 CAMRY CNG ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
P ow er S ou rce
S ta rtin g an d Ig nitio n
1
C h arg in g
4
3
2
W
B–Y
ACC
3 1K
8 1T
1 1K
5A
STARTER
5A
IGN
W
I10
IGNITION SW
3 1J
4 B
8 1C
10A GAUGE
ST2 8
C10 A , C11 B
13 A
5 1K
B–Y
4 1K
CHARGE WARNING
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
IG2 6
B–R
W–R 7 AM2
R
B–R
IG1 4
B–R
2 AM1
W
B–R
2 1J
5 1B
B
B–R
2
3 2B
5 2D
9 2K
P
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
10 IG2
B A
1
N1
NOISE FILTER
(Ignition)
6 EB1
R–L
GR
Y
FL MAIN
3. 0W
J18
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
Intake manifold
EC
G1 B , G2 A
A
BR
GENERATOR
IF
To Engine Control
Module<2–11>
BR
Instrument panel
brace LH
To Engine Control
Module<2–11>
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
To Bulb Check Relay
[Comb. Meter]<17–6>
BATTERY
4 IJ2
4
BR
B A
2
Y–R
B A
3
W–R
1 B
GR
B–G
1
A
3
W–R
B–R
2
B
STARTER
1 A
4
BR
J6 A , J7 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
S1 A , S2 B
I3
IGNITION
COIL AND
IGNITER
IGF IGT GND NO. 2
Y
C B
+B
W–R
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
C
1
+B
I2
IGNITION
COIL AND
IGNITER
NO. 1
GND IGT IGF
GR
GR
B–R
W–B
F 9 A , F10 B ,
F11 C , F14 F
100A
ALT
C
4 IE2
B–R
1 C
C
1
B
B–R
B–R
6
GR
11 2J
B–R
3
J19
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
C
B–R
B–G
1
5
B–W
ST RELAY
40A MAIN
B–R
30A AM2
5A ALT–S
1
B
2 F
12 IG3
11 IG2
5
N
1 F
R–L
2
1 2A
1 B
B–W
B
4 2L
1
1 1B
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B–W
Y
W–R
W
40A AM1
3 2C
B–R
2
B–W
To Engine Control
Module<2–10>
2 1K
1 A
L
B B
IG A
S A
1
B–G
2
3
W
B
7. 5A OBD
40A AM1
B–R
B–R
B–R
Left radiator
side support
L–B
L–B
W–B
30A AM2
B–R
B–R
EB
1 IG2
1
W–B
B–G
BK
A
2
W–B
BATTERY
G–R
FL MAIN
3. 0W
E A
4 IB1
3
4
LG–B
B–Y
Under the left
center pillar
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 IG1
LG–B
F 9 A , F11 C , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
5 EB1
B–Y
E A
1
F17
FUEL TEMP. SENSOR AND
FUEL SHUTOFF VALVE (Fuel Tank)
1 A
G–R
4 EB1
B A
L–W
100A
ALT
B
1 C
CIR OPN RELAY
G–R
10 IF1
R–L
1
2
B A
BR
1
3
2
2
LG–B
2 F
EFI RELAY
10 2C 4 2F 5 2C
J23 A , J24 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
PIM
2
3
VC
E2
1
BR
3
4
1
2
B
B–Y
G–R
G–R
L–R
LG–B
B–Y
LG
Y
BR
L–B
B–R
B–Y
B–Y
B–Y
O
N
M
L
K
J
I
H
G
F
E
D
C
B
A
(Cont. next page)
BR
1 F
20A EFI
2 2J
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B B
B–Y
B–R
1 2A
7
D
L–B
1
1
1
9 IG3
3 IG2
BR
1 1B
2
5
1
R–L
3
1
D
2 IB1
BR
7 IB1
BR
4 1B
W–R
5
B–R
B–Y
2
B–Y
7 2K
2 1D
10A
GAUGE
L–B
8 2J
5A
IGN
1 1K
L–B
4 2L
B–R
7 1W
3 1K
BR
BR
2 1K
I10
IGNITION SW
B–R
B–R
B–R
3
E ng in e C ontro l
BR
10 1J
W
5 1B
5 1K
ST2
IG2 6
IG1 4
B–Y
7 AM2
2 AM1
ACC
2
B–Y
W–R
1
P o w er S o urc e
2 CAMRY CNG
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
T1
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
Y
LG
M1
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
Y
B–Y
A11
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
L–R
B–Y
B–Y
B–Y
C12
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
[COMB. METER]
B
G–R
B–R
W–B
B–Y
B–Y
B–Y
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL VALVE
P
P–B
L
W
Y–R
L
Y–R
G–W
B–R
B–Y
B–Y
B–L
G–W
E3
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMP. SENSOR
I8
INTAKE AIR TEMP.
SENSOR
Y–B
G–B
F7
FUEL SHUTOFF VALVE
(Fuel Pressure Regulator)
L–B
Y–G
P2
POWER STEERING
OIL PRESSURE SW
Y–R
L
V2
VSV(EGR)
F6
FUEL SHUTOFF VALVE
(Delivery Pipe)
From Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
<14–4>
From Combination
Meter<17–6>
L–B
BR
BR
BR
P–B
G–O
B–Y
P–B
B–R
B
P–B
From ” TAIL” Fuse
<8–2>
From ” MIRROR–HEATER”
Fuse<18–1>
H6
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
BR
B–R
B
(Shielded)
(Shielded)
W
(Shielded)
G–R
G–R
L–R
LG–B
B–Y
LG
Y
Y
B–Y
From Center
Airbag Sensor
Assembly<14–4>
W–B
J6 A , J7 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
BR
BR
B
B B
A B
7 1J
W–B
BR
BR
D
BR
BR
E1
E
Instrument
panel
brace LH
IF
4
BR
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
HT
3
F8
FUEL TEMP. SENSOR
(Delivery Pipe)
G–B
G–R
G–R
F5
FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
(Fuel Pipe)
BR
F4
FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
(Delivery Pipe)
G–B
Y
12 IG2
B–Y
N
B
O
1
OX
W–B
8 IG1
3
1
2
Y
2
G–R
L
G–R
M
BR
SIL
+B
L–R
K
8 1J
J
7
C A
C A
A A
LG–B
C
3
B–Y
I
5
4
SG
CG
BAT
W–B
9 IG1
D6
DIODE
(Idle–Up)
2 IG3
Y
VC
VC
16
H
LG
3
3
1 IG3
G
2
W
W
ELS
HT2
RSD
VOUT
1
D3
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
3 D
21 C
5 B
16 A
OX2
SIL
FC
W
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
5 A 14 A
10 B
1 D
THR
PIM THCNG1
VTA
VC
2 B
1 B 11 B
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C , E7 D
10 C
4 D
23 C
VCNG3
EGR
F/PS
FUELW
FUEL
12 D
8 D
2 D
12 B
1 A
PSW
BATT
+B
+B1
VCNG2
12 A
22 A
9 D
4 B
3 B
9 B
THW
THA
E2
THCNG2
PCNG1 PCNG2
6 D
5 D
7 D
GND
2
VOUT
1
BR
1
C
GND
2
2
2
2
2
BR
6 IG1
2
2
1
5 IG1
A
4 IH1
1
A
1
J8
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
9 IF1
1
1
1
1
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
F
A
B–Y
B
B
E
B–R
D
L–B
B
B
B
J18
B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
B–Y
B
B
B–Y
B
8
7
6
5
B–Y
A
(Cont. next page)
2 CAMRY CNG (Cont’ d)
E n gine C on trol
M
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
W–B
W–B
BR
A
1
2
2
W
1
#40
#40+
24 C
I7
INJECTOR NO. 4
O
(Shielded)
A
Cowl side
panel RH
IH
E
BR
BR
6 IG3
BR
D
W–B
C
B
B
A
2
1
#10
12 C
#10+
L
(Shielded)
B–Y
W–B
I4
INJECTOR NO. 1
B–W
2 C
14 B
AF–
HTAF
7 IG1
G
2 A
4
AF–
HT
G
1
AF+
3
2
+B
9
B–W
A
A
W–B
(Shielded)
4 IG1
A
2
BR
1
#20
11 C
#20+
AF+
6 B
B–R
1 C
I5
INJECTOR NO. 2
(Shielded)
A8
AIR FUEL
RATIO SENSOR
J21
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
A
2
G
1
#30
25 C
I6
INJECTOR NO. 3
R
(Shielded)
L
EC
Intake
manifold
BR
1
2
G
5 C
17 C
NE–
NE
4 C
B–R
14 C
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
C1
CAMSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
(Shielded)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 CAMRY CNG (Cont’ d)
L
BR
J23 A
BR
3 IG1
E04
IGT2
3 C 19 C
IGF
IGT1
STA
20 C
B–O
L
C2
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
#30+
B–O
B–W
15 C
To Tachometer
[Comb. Meter]
<17–5>
NSW
11 A
V–W
LOCK
6 A
G–W
From Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]
<17–8>
8 A
From Stop Light SW
<8–4>
4 A
W–L
9 A
W–L
F A
10
To A/C Magnetic
Clutch and Lock
Sensor<19–4>
G
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C , E7 D
G
From A/C Dual
Pressure SW<19–4>
15 A
L–Y
10 A
From MG CLT
Relay<19–2>
10 D 21 A
R–B
18 C
From A/C SW
<19–4>
1 IG1
R–W
10 IG3
From A/C SW
<19–4>
A/CS
B–W
MGC
From ” STARTER”
Fuse<1–2>
PRS
GR
LOCK IN
From Park/Neutral
Position SW<1–2>
F A
E ng ine C o ntrol
B
BR
(Shielded)
STP
W–R
SPD
11
From Ignition Coil
and Igniter
No. 1, No. 2<1–3>
TACH
Y–R
BR
A
BR
A
A
BR
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BR A
BR
BR
BR
BR
A
BR
A
BR
Intake
manifold
BR
EC
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
J18
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E03
E02
E01
13 C 22 C 16 B
EO5
E1
BR
16 C
TE1
15 B
TE1
8
+B
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
12
L–W
BR
13 A
12
B–Y
BR
26 C
3
E1
BR
M
3 CAMRY CNG
P o w e r S ou rc e
E le c tron ic ally C o ntro lled T ra ns m is s io n a nd A /T In dic ato r
1
2
3
R–L
ACC
2 AM1
W
IG1 4
3 1K
B–Y
1 1K
F B
1 1J
7
Y
E
3 IG3
A
D
L–W
7 2K 8 2J
D
R–B
R–B
A
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–R
D
B–R
B–R
E
B–Y
4 2L
9 IG2
R
W
E
L–W
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
4 IG2
G–W
6 IG2
R
2 1D
B–R
1 IH1
G–W
PL
8
R–B
RL
9
5 IG2
5 1B
2 1K
NL
10
Y
I10
IGNITION SW
DL
3
B–R
2
IG2
7 1W
5 1K
2L
4
To Cruise
Control ECU
<13–2>
B–R
LL
L–W
ST2
D
P1
A/T INDICATOR
LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW]
Y
B–R
10A
GAUGE
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
IG2 6
2
RB
R–L
5A
IGN
D
J24 B
F B
W–R 7 AM2
4
R–L
R–L
B–Y
B–R
A
2
1
5
R–B
G–O
C
O2
O/D MAIN
SW
11 IF1
A
W–B
2
4
A
W–B
A
EC
EC
Intake manifold
W–B
A
Intake
manifold
C10 A , C11 B , C12 C
COMBINATION METER
G–O
E1 A , E2 B
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
16 B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
G–O
A
9 A
IE
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Left kick panel
P
12 A
BR
Left radiator
side support
OD2
7 A
G–O
A
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
NO. 2
NO. 1
LOCK–UP
From
Cruise Control
ECU<13–3>
A
J18
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
W
B–Y
S2
From Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]
<17–8>
BR
BR
BR
BR
1 B
S1
BR
BR
L–B
3 B
L–B
B A
8 A
C
7 IG2
G–W
SPD
9 A
V–W
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B L–B
E02
10 A
R
E01
13 C 22 C
R–B
E03
16 B
7 A
N
E1
16 C
11 A
R
E04
13 A
BR
EB
IDLO
3 IG1
B
1 A
E05
26 C
W–B
BATTERY
V
B B
OD1
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
BR
L–B
B
R
6 A
15 IF1
3 A
D
S2
6 C
2
7 C
B–R
S1
7 C
L
20 A
10 1H
O/D OFF
SL
8 C
P
B–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
+B
12 A
B–Y
1 A
J23 A , J24 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
100A
ALT
F 9 A , F11 C , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
1 C
STP
17 A
14 IF1
2
TE1
E4 A , E5 B , E6 C
19 A 18 A
13 IF1
O
E2
4 A
16 IF1
L
THW
15 B
D
Y
VTA
9 B
5 1V
D
R–L
VC
4 B
L–R
11 B
Y–B
NSW
1 B
R–B
6 A
+B1
L–W
BATT
Y
B–Y
W–B
W–B
B
B–R
B–R
2 F
B–R
B–Y
B–R
1 F
1 A 22 A
J23 A , J24 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
3
5 2C 4 2F 2 2J
1 2A
From Cruise
Control ECU
<13–3>
See Engine Control System
<2–5><2–6><2–10><2–12>
A B
1 1B
R–B
L–W
2
C A
Y
1
C A
R–L
20A
EFI
J3
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
EFI RELAY
40A AM1
30A
AM2
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
4 CAMRY CNG
P ow er S o urc e
H e ad lig ht
1
2
4
1
HEAD
RELAY
40A
MAIN
4
3
2
15A
HEAD
(RH)
15A
HEAD
(LH)
3
2
1
3 2B
8 2K 3 2G
4 2G
6 2G
8 2C
R–W
R
R–B
R–B
B
J31
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
B
B
R–B
B
2
3
J25 A , J26 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
H
T
HF HL
D A
HI
F A
F A
OFF
R–L
R–L
TAIL
HEAD
LOW
3 IE1
HIGH
R–L
FLASH
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
16
BATTERY
D B
8
R–B
LIGHT
DIMMER SW
CONTROL SW
B–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
D B
R–L
13
EL
R–L
C15
COMBINATION SW
F B
2
R–Y
1 A
F B
4
1
R–B
F 9 A , F11 C
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
H2
HEADLIGHT
RH
1
R–B
R–B
I11
INTEGRATION
RELAY
1 C
3
H1
HEADLIGHT
LH
17
7
8
R–B
C11
HIGH BEAM
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
A
R–L
A
9
W–B
W–B
8 1J
A
7 1J
A
W–B
W–B
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
IE
Left kick panel
5 CAMRY CNG
P ow er S ourc e
T urn S ig nal and H az ard W arning Light
1
B ac k– U p L ig ht
3
2
4
B–Y
ACC
2 AM1
B
IG1 4
1 1K
1 2A
F
3 2K
R–L
40A
AM1
G–B
W
10
TB
2 IG2
R–L
H5
HAZARD SW
2
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
1 1J
G–R
2 1K
F
10A
HAZARD
R–L
2 1L
R–L
R–L
10A GAUGE
W
7. 5A TURN
I10
IGNITION SW
2
8
B1
TL
B2
TL
TR
LH
ON
RH
C15
TURN SIGNAL SW
[COMB. SW]
D
1
7
9
5
3
G–Y
2
G–Y
D
G–Y
D
B–R
G–B
2 F
5 1A
3
6 1H
10 1C
6 1S
2 1A
3
R9
BACK–UP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
R–B
W–B
Back panel center
1
C
5 1V
C
W–B
W–B
BM
W–B
W–B
IE
R7
BACK–UP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
R–B
J23
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
F2
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
3
3
13 1S
R–B
A
W–B
Left kick panel
R–B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B B
G–Y
W–B
A
R–B
R–B
J25 A , J26 B
A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
3 IG3
B A
W–B
W–B
Left radiator
side support
8
G–Y
5
R10
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–Y
C11 B , C12 C
6
W–B
EB
TURN SIGNAL INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
IF
G–Y
Instrument panel
brace LH
16 B
W–B
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
A
W–B
2
BATTERY
F1
FRONT TURN
SIGNAL LIGHT LH
G–B
3
1 C
LH
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
5
1 EB1
1 B
RH
B–G
B
C
6
G–B
G–B
1 C
C
G–B
C
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R8
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
G–B
100A
ALT
D
G–Y
P1
BACK–UP LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
8 1H
11 1S
G–B
F 9 A , F11 C ,
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–Y
8 1V
T2
TURN SIGNAL
FLASHER
B–R
B–R
1 F
1
G–B
2
1 A
1
6
G–B
G–W
G–R
1 1B
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
TR
R–L
OFF
D
TB
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Under the left
center pillar
BK
M
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
6 CAMRY CNG
P o w e r S ou rc e
Ligh t A uto T u rn O ff
In te rio r L igh t
1
2
B
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
1
B–Y
C17
CONDENSER
2
1
R
R
From Light Failure
Sensor<8–4>
To Clock<12–4>
SHORT
PIN
B
25A
DOOR
W
2 1K
1 1D
1
1 1K
D B
J16 A , J17 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C B
12 2J
E A
5 1F
L–W
6
I11 B ,
4
I12 A
2
12 1S
10
1
2
R–W
G–R
R–W
G–R
R–W
R–W
1
D4
DIODE
(Courtesy)
11
11 1H 6 1F 1 1M
R–W
R–G
4 1G
R–W
W–B
R–G
7 1S
2
1
INTEGRATION RELAY
7 1J
I9
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
10
1
L4
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT
1
13 A
ON
OFF
8 A
F 9 A , F11 C , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
2
R–Y
R–W
R–G
R–G
1 A
7
4 B
DOOR
2 F
100A
ALT
3 B
I13
INTERIOR LIGHT
1 F
2 B
B–R
B–R
1 C
1 B
C11
OPEN DOOR WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
2
B–R
R
R
2 1M
R
R
8 1G
E A
R
R–Y
9 1S
R
R
1 1W
A A
B–R
B
B–R
R
1 1B
J31 A , J32 B
1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
See Headlight
System<4–2>
See Taillight
System<8–1>
10A
GAUGE
2 R
7. 5A
DOME
L–W
2
R
D5
DIODE
(Dome)
2
R–Y
I10
IGNITION SW
40A
AM1
R
1 2A
4 1B
4
3
B
B–R
B–G
E A
E A
D A
D A
D A
FL MAIN
3. 0W
D B
J31 A , J32 B
1
BATTERY
8 IM1
1
D10
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
R–W
1
D9
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
1
D8
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
R–G
1
D7
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
IF
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
R–G
W–B
A
6 IM1
L5
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
R–W
R–W
R–G
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
M
7 CAMRY CNG
P o w e r S ou rc e
Illu m ina tio n
1
4
3
2
G
G
1
5
G
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
G
7. 5A
PANEL
2
A A
3
A A
A A
A A
J28 A , J29 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4 1B
6 1C
4 1J
5 1D
G
3
B
B
W–G
A
A
A
A A
W–B
W–B
B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
A A
2
W–B
B
B
B
J13 A , J14 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
12
A B
B–G
A A
G
5 B
1
G3
GLOVE BOX LIGHT AND SW
3
1
13
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C12
COMBINATION METER ILLUMINATION
[COMB. METER]
2
R2 B , R3 A
RADIO AND PLAYER
2
10 A
H5
HAZARD SW
A18
ASHTRAY
ILLUMINATION
1
O2
A/T SHIFT LEVER ILLUMINATION
[O/D MAIN SW]
G
G
B4
BLOWER SW
6
7
A B
B B
G
3
B
B
A B
4
A12
A/C SW
1
B
A B
C8
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
ILLUMINATION
2
2
B B
G
G
R4
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
6
B B
G
B B
G
B B
B A
G
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
G
1 A
F 9 A , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
100A
ALT
B A
G
See Taillight System
<8–1>
B–R
2 F
A B
J13 A , J14 B
B–R
B–R
1 F
A B
G
B
B
E
B
3
D
A
D
A
B
6
1V
4
1H
B
E
B
D
A
1
E
T
ILL
2 R6
RHEOSTAT
B
BATTERY
J16 A , J17 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
IE
Left kick panel
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
8 CAMRY CNG
W
G–W
G–W
J23 A , J24 B
R–L
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
G–W
G–W
R–L
G–R
G–O
G
B–R
G
Y–G
G
G
To Cruise
Control ECU
<13–4>
2 1H
G–R
B–R
To Shift Lock ECU
<12–3>
R
G–R
G–O
To Diode(Idle–Up)
<2–8>
G
G
G–O
G
G–O
W–B
G–O
H8
HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
R
To Condenser
<6–3>
R10
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
R8
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
W–B
R9
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–O
W–B
R7
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
G–O
W–B
R10
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
SIDE
MARKER
TAIL
R8
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
SIDE
MARKER
TAIL
W–B
W–B
F2
FRONT PARKING LIGHT RH
G–O
F1
FRONT PARKING LIGHT LH
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
B–G
W–B
W–B
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
G–W
G–W
Y–G
G
G
L2
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT RH
W–B
L1
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT LH
W–B
G–O
G–O
I11
INTEGRATION RELAY
B–R
2
S4
STOP LIGHT SW
To Engine
Control Module
<2–10>
G–W
W
14
F 9 A , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
A
W–B
W–B
A
Under the left
center pillar
BK
BM
Back panel
center
Back panel
center
5
5
3
W–B
W–B
A
BM
BK
Under the left
center pillar
W–B
W–B
2
2
4
1
2
9
11
1
5
5
W–B
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
EB
Left radiator
side support
IF
Instrument panel
brace LH
A
BATTERY
W–B
8
1J
7
1J
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
2
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
TAIL
G–R
G–O
G–O
G–O
4
HEAD
FL MAIN
3. 0W
16
C15
COMBINATION SW
EL
3
A
1
3
1
3
1
1
OFF
5 IC2
A
7
4
8
3
B–R
2 F
H
T
1 A
1
1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A A
C B
C B
1
100A
ALT
2
2 1S
A
2
4 1R
2
J25 A , J26 B
5 1R
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
B–R
G
8 1S
2
To ABS ECU
<15–3>
W
D
1
3 A
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A A
9 1C
L3
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
1 F
A
A A
7 C
6 1C
4 1B
A
C10 A , C12 C
REAR LIGHTS
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
C B
1
R–L
2
1D
C B
1 1B
B–Y
ACC
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 1S
3
2
D
10A
TAIL
15A
STOP
40A
AM1
10A
GAUGE
7 1C
5
1
2
1 1K
I10
IGNITION SW
2 1K
B–Y
IG1 4
2 AM1
4
3
2
1
S to p L igh t
T aillig ht
P ow er S o urc e
M
9 CAMRY CNG
P ow er S o urc e
W ipe r a nd W as he r
1
B–Y
I10
IGNITION SW
* 1 : w/ Mirror Heater
* 2 : w/o Mirror Heater
L–R
L–R
IG1 4
4
3
2
ACC 3
2 AM1
R e mo te C on trol M irro r
1 1K
6 1K
W
25A
WIPER
4 1C
1 1A
40A
AM1
E A
+B
+2
+1
+S
INT1
INT2
B1
EW
P–L
2
1 1T
C13
WIPER AND WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
L
J25 A , J26 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 1K
15A
CIG
WF
A
OFF
A
LO
P–L
E B
1
HI
M
WF
EW
WIPER RELAY
+2
2
8
+1
7
+S
LEFT
+B
16
RIGHT
UP
L
L–Y
L–B
L–O
6 IJ1
DOWN
LEFT/
UP
HL
VR
7
14 ID1
15 ID1
16 IL1
14 IL1
W–B
16 ID1
C
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG–R
LG–B
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
BR–R
2
B
LG–R
1
S
BR–Y
5
+1
10
C
BR–W
B–G
+2
E
6
C
L
1 A
M+
LG–B
LG–R
A
1
BR–Y
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
VL
BR–R
A
L
MV
HR
8
5
L–W
3
RIGHT/
DOWN
17
MH
W–B
F 9 A , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
100A
ALT
11
SELECT
SW
B–R
B–R
2 F
L–W
1
1 F
WASHER
OPERATION
SW
B–R
W2
WASHER
MOTOR
2
R5
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
9
B
L
L
1 1B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
INT
15 IL1
4 2F
4
3 A
4 A
2 A
3 A (*1)
1 B
2 B
3 B
1 B
2 B (*2)
M
M
M
M
A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
Instrument panel
brace LH
LG–R
2 A
3 B
F3
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
LG–B
A
BR–R
E
4 A
W–B
W–B
BATTERY
LG–R
10 2J
BR–Y
BR–W
W–B
M
Left radiator
side support
EB
R13 A , B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH
R14 A , B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH
IE
Left kick
panel
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
10 CAMRY CNG
P ow er S ou rce
P o w er W ind ow
1
4
3
2
L
B–R
R–B
ACC
2 AM1
10 ID2
IG1 4
5 1G 4 1B
12 1G
L
B
I10
IGNITION SW
1
B
B
25A
DOOR
30A
POWER
L
L
B–Y
W
J33
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
10
BW
2
1 1K
FRONT LH
13
12 ID2
R–B
R–B
6 ID2
G–B
G–B
9 ID2
R–Y
R–Y
7 ID2
G–Y
5 ID2
R
G
W–B
J33
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
11 ID2
1 IC1
5 IC1
5 IM1
7 IM1
A
A
9
IM1
L
L
L
R–Y
L
G–B
R–B
3 BA1
1 BB1
2 BB1
3 BB1
R–B
L
5
B
U
D
1
5
R
G
R
2
1
M
P11
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR LH
4
SD
DOWN
D
1
2
SU
UP
U
P7
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR RH
B
G
2
1
M
P10
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
FRONT RH
3
DOWN
1
4
SD
R–B
G–B
D
3
2
SU
UP
U
P6
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR LH
B
R
P9
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
FRONT LH
3
DOWN
2
2
SD
G
ID
M
5
SU
UP
Cowl side
panel LH
1
P5
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW FRONT RH
IF
W–B
Instrument panel
brace LH
R
G
W–B
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 BA1
G–W
L
W–B
B–G
4
3 1V
5 IL2
L
4 IL2
R–L
W–B
6 IL2
G–B
G–Y
2 BA1
L
See Light Auto Turn Off
System<6–1><6–2>
F 9 A , F14 F
100A ALT
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
L A
A
7 1G
A
DOWN
RRD
8
A
FL MAIN
3. 0W
UP
RRU
12
20 ID1
BATTERY
DOWN
RLD
9
G–Y
5
UP
DD
1
RLU
6
R–L
DU
4
PD
14
R–L
E
3
PU
G–W
E
REAR RH
G–W
13 1G
L
L
W–B
L–W
B–R
B–R
A A
1 A
3 1S
J31 A , J32 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C B
2 F
7 1J
L–W
13 A
7 1S
B–R
3
LOCK
1 1D
8 A
2
10
12 A
6
NORMAL
WINDOW LOCK SW
R–B
7
I12 A
B–R
B–R
INTEGRATION
RELAY
1 1B
5
POWER
RELAY
1
REAR LH
DOWN
1
10A GAUGE
40A
AM1
FRONT RH
UP
UP
2
1 F
DOWN
2 1K
P8
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
11
BW
2
1
M
P12
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR RH
MEMO
W
L–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J31 A , J32 B
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
LG
W–B
LOCK
LG
ID
UNLOCK
B–G
Cowl side
panel LH
W–B
7
1G
W–B
3
1V
W–B
P8
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LH
[POWER WINDOW MASTER SW]
G
UNLOCK
W–B
II
Right kick panel
W–B
Instrument panel
brace LH
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
J35
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
4
BK
D14
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT LH
IF
A
W–B
M
3
L–R
2
11 ID1
8 ID2
7 A
W–B
6
BA1
M
3
Under the left
center pillar
A
2
4
1
4 BA1
7 BA1
5 BA1
6
IC2
7
IC2
11 A
6 A 10 A
L–Y
L–B
L–B
L–B
L–R
L–R
L–R
Y
L–Y
L–Y
L–R
W–B
D16
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW REAR LH
BATTERY
B
3 ID2
L–R
L–B
20 IL1
A
D12
DOOR KEY LOCK
AND UNLOCK SW
FRONT RH
L
UNLOCK
J35
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
L–B
20 ID1
L–W
A
See Key Reminder and
Seat Belt Warning
System<16–2>
L–R
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
LOCK
W–B
D11
DOOR KEY LOCK
AND UNLOCK SW
FRONT LH
L–W
LOCK
A
1
3
L–R
L–R
J33
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
2
L–R
L–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
R–G
A
1
2
See Light Auto Turn
Off System<6–1><6–2>
F 9 A , F11 C , F14 F
D13
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW RH
G
UNLOCK
W–B
3
7 1S
6
L–R
L–Y
1 A
3
5
3 IL1
8 A
L–B
100A
ALT
6
4 IL1
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 C
LG
7
4 ID1
F
F
9 A
L–B
2 F
4
G
2
3 ID1
5 1M
5
4
L–R
1 F
1 2A
1
LG
12 IL1
G
13 IL1
R–G
12 ID1
L–W
13 ID1
E
L–W
4 1B
25A
DOOR
SHORT
PIN
D
A
A
L
1 1B
B–R
L–W
2
B
B
J27
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
40A
AM1
L–Y
D
B
5 A
3 A
L–R
2
D
B
B
4 A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
I12 A
INTEGRATION RELAY
R–G
1 1D
L–W
7. 5A
DOME
R
20A
RADIO
NO. 1
W–B
C B
1 A
LG
J5
JUNCTION
E CONNECTOR
E
2 A
G
12 2J
7 1J
10
L–W
1 1W
1
3
L
11 2K
13 A
2
Y
A A
L–R
D o or L oc k C o ntrol
L
K
J
I
H
G
F
E
D
C
B
A
(Cont. next page)
L–Y
2 1K
IG1
ACC 3
I10
IGNITION SW
2 AM1
1
P ow er S o urc e
11 CAMRY CNG
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
W–B
W–B
W–B
LOCK
11 CAMRY CNG (Cont’ d)
D oo r L oc k C on trol
A
B
R ad io an d P lay er
5
L–R
8
7
6
L–Y
L–Y
L–R
5 1W
6 1K
7. 5A
RAD–NO. 2
L–Y
L–Y
L–B
L–Y
7 IL2
3 IL2
11 IL1
5 BB1
7 BB1
4 BB1
W–B
IJ
RR+
RR–
1 B
3 B
BL
GND
7 A
1 IL1
1
2
1
2
F16
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
9 IC1
3 IC1
10 IC1
4 IC1
1
2
R11
REAR SPEAKER
LH
1
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
RH
BR
Right kick panel
RL–
6 B
W–B
W–B
9 IL1
1 ID1
F15
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
6 BB1
W–B
RL+
2 B
W
4
FR–
5 A
9 ID1
P
M
W–B
L
1
D17
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW REAR RH
3
L–Y
1
2
L–B
M
L–R
4
D15
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT RH
L–Y
3
Y
2
L–B
2 IC2
L–R
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
FR+
1 A
BR
L–R
J28 A , J29 B
Y
L–Y
6 A
W
B
A
FL–
2 A
R
L–B
FL+
3 IM1
R
L–B
Y
C
B
Y
B
A
B
L–B
1
IM1
B
L–B
L
C
B
L
B
A
ACC +B
LG
L–B
BU +B
LG
L–R
RADIO AND PLAYER
V
B
B
3 A
V
C
A
R2 B , R3 A
4 A
P
L–R
2
IM1
L–B
K
L–R
L–R
J
B
B
GR
I
C
A
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
L–Y
H
L–R
A
B
L–Y
G
C
A
Y
F
L–R
B
L–Y
C
E
E B
GR
J28
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
Y
3 1H
L–Y
D
L–Y
6 1G
J10 A , J11 B
C
D A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D A
Under the right
center pillar
Instrument
panel brace
RH
IG
M
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
12 CAMRY CNG
P ow er S ou rce
1
2
2 AM1
ACC 3
L–R
IG1 4
B–Y
C ig are tte L igh ter an d C loc k
4
3
G
L–R
W
P ow er
O utle t
S h ift Lo c k
1 1K
G
I10
IGNITION SW
6 1K
15A
ECU–IG
G
W
5 1D
2 1K
8 1D
15A
POWER–
OUTLET
B–R
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
G–W
3
ACC
STP SLS+
L–R
5
1
4 1B
1 1B
L–B
A
4 1V
7 1J
3 1V
Instrument panel
brace LH
W–B
W–B
IF
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
ID
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
1
A
Left kick
panel
2
A
BATTERY
IE
4
W–B
A
2
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–B
K1
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
1
W–B
8 1J
A
1
3
W–B
W–B
5 IE1
B–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
1
2
R
C9
CLOCK
S3
SHIFT LOCK ECU
4
W–B
1 A
F 9 A , F14 F
100A
ALT
KLS+
5
A B
G
2 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
See Taillight
System<8–1>
E
1 F
2
2
G
A
P–L
B–R
B–R
P
G–R 3
P4
POWER OUTLET
P1
A A
A
SHIFT LOCK
CONTROL SW
C7
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
B–R
B–R
B–R
P2
G–W 1
A
From Diode(Dome)
<6–4>
6 1C
P–L
SLS–
SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID
1
2
L
V
1
1 1T
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
40A
AM1
6 1J
J28 A , J29 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
IG
2
6
P–L
3
5 1J
1
P–L
2
From Stop Light SW
<8–4>
P–L
B–R
7. 5A
PANEL
15A
CIG
A
Cowl side
panel LH
IF
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
IE
Left kick panel
M
13 CAMRY CNG
P ow er S o urc e
C ru is e C o ntro l
1
4
3
2
ACC
2 AM1
W
IG1 4
B–Y
2 1K
I10
IGNITION SW
2
1 1K
40A
AM1
15A
ECU–IG
B–R
R–L
B–R
C
9
PI
TC
14
IDL
8
12
OD
5
CMS
11
CCS
SPD
4
1
L
A A
M
8 1J
W–B
4
7 1J
BATTERY
W–B
W–B
To Data Link
Connector 1, 2
<15–3>
To Data Link
Connector 2
<15–3>
CANCEL
EP
3 C14
CRUISE CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
IF
Instrument panel
brace LH
From Stop Light
SW<8–4>
A A
3
2
G–W
A A
2
C3
CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
O
SET/
COAST
1
A B
STP–
R–Y
W–B
CRUISE
RESUME/
ACCEL
MC
7
R–B
CMS CCS
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
4
MO
15
R–G
D
D
J6 A , J7 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
5
O
16
W
W–L
O
LG–R
O
B–G
5 IE2
GND
10
W–B
4
10
1 A
FL MAIN
3. 0W
13
ECT
See Stop Light
System<8–4>
C12
CRUISE CONTROL
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
6
D
R–Y
100A
ALT
C16
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
3
B
7
2
V–W
2 F
3
B–R
B–R
R–L
F 9 A , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
1 F
Y–B
C
L–R
D
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–B
B–R
B–R
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–B
S4
STOP LIGHT SW
D
From Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]<17–8>
9 1J
From D Position SW
[Park/Neutral Position SW]
<3–4>
2 1D
To Engine Control Module
<3–3>
To Electronically
Controlled Transmission
Solenoid<3–2>
1 1B
See Stop Light
System<8–4>
10A
GAUGE
1
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
14 CAMRY CNG
P o w e r S ou rc e
SR S
1
4
3
2
W–R
ACC 3
W
2 AM1
W–R
A9
AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT LH
L–R
A10
AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT RH
3 1W
IG1
B–R
12
A
3 1K
5 1K
6 1K
2
13
1
2
7 IG3
A
A
LG
4 1N
2 1K
2 1N
1
II1
2
II1
4 2L
A
IG2
26 B
ACC
15 B
–SL
E1
1 1B
1 2A
27 B
D+
14 B
D–
P+
P–
13 B
10 B
11 B
20 B
+SL
C4 A , C5 B , C6 C
1
1
B–W
6 B
5 B
BR–W
30A
AM2
W–R
SHORT
PIN
40A
AM1
BR
2
GR
B–O
2
9 B
–SR
+SR
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
PL+
PL–
PR+
PR–
2 A
1 A
5 C
6 C
E2
SIL
28 B
12 B
GSW
4 B
L
To Data Link Connector 3
<2–7>
To Engine Control
Module<2–7>
B
W
B–R
B–R
B–R
W–B
Y
Y–B
Y
Y–B
Y–G
Y–R
Y
1 A
B–G
F 9 A , F11 C , F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
100A
ALT
1 C
Y–B
2 F
W–B
1 F
1 1N
7 1J
1
2
SPIRAL
CABLE
3 1N
1
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
2
1
2
1
2
3 1V
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
IF
A16
AIRBAG SQUIB
(Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly)
P13
PRETENSIONER LH
P14
PRETENSIONER RH
W–B
A
BATTERY
A17
AIRBAG SQUIB
(Steering
Wheel Pad)
ID
Cowl side
panel LH
P–B
2 IE2
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG
B–Y
B–W
BR–W
W–R
2 IA1
W–R
1 IA1
LG
1
15A
CIG
B
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
BR
10A ECU–B
5 1B
A
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
I10
IGNITION SW
5A
IGN
B
LG
7 2J
To Data Link
Connector 1
<15–3>
IG2 6
ST2
C11
SRS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
7 AM2
W–R
W–R
W
W–R
To Data Link
Connector 1, 2
<15–3>
2 1G
3 B
19 B
LA
TC
M
15 CAMRY CNG
P ow er S ou rce
AB S
1
2 AM1
IG1 4
R–L
B–Y
4 IG3
BR
A13 A , A14 B
ABS ECU
24 B
5 B
D/G
STP
2 A
8 A
FL–
FL+
6 IG3
9 A
3 A
FR–
FR+
RR–
23 B
RR+
10 B
1 B
5 A
SFLR SRRH SRRR
6 A 11 A
12 A
SRLH
15 B
SRLR
14 B
MT
GND GND
25 B 12 B
10 A
RL–
9 B
RL+
22 B
W
9 IB1
3 IB1
1 IK1
B
SRLR MT
A
A
A
2 IK1
BR
FL MAIN
3. 0W
M
E
1 A
2
W–B
W–R
W–L
BM
2 A
A
W–B
W–B
W–R
W
G
BS
4 A
BATTERY
B
A4 A , A5 B
ABS ACTUATOR
W–B
SRLH
3 A
W–B
SRRH SRRR
6 B
R
2 B
R–W
SFLR
8 B
LG–B
SFRR SFLH
4 B
5 IJ2
G–Y
7 B
R–G
3 B
W–R
SFRH
W–L
5 B
L–B
W–R
B–G
1 B
13 IJ2
R
G
12 IJ2
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG–B
G–Y
W–R
11 IJ2
R–B
F 9 A , F10 B ,
F14 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
EA
Right radiator
side support
IF
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
1
A19
ABS SPEED
SENSOR
REAR LH
2
1
A20
ABS SPEED
SENSOR
REAR RH
Intake manifold
BR
SFRR SFLH
1 B
BR
SFRH
2 B
R–B
100A
ALT
1 A
W
TC
B
LG–R
B B
BR
R
8 B
TS
P–B
B
G–W
J2
JUNCTION B
CONNECTOR
B
C A
J6 A , J7 B
R
1 IJ2
G
B
A7
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
1
2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
From Stop Light
SW<8–4>
From Cruise Control
ECU<13–2>
From Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly<14–4>
6 IJ2
B
21 B
WA
14
LG–R
11 B
IG1
11 IG3
R–Y
13 B
R+
ABS
4
R–L
C
12 IF1
G–B
2 F
SR
4
R–L
1 F
GR–R
GR
GR–L
7 A 26 B
MR
C
C
O
B–R
W–L
W–B
GR–L
W–R
B–G
B–R
B–R
1 A
7
G–B
GR
B–R
1 IJ1
TC
TC
LG–R
3
8 IG3
A6
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
1
2
BR
LG–R
3
5 IG3
3
LG–R
3
D
R–Y
3
C
A/D E1
11
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–B
3
6
D
16
G–B
3
3
C
TS
22
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
R–L
4
5
E1
BR
3
10
AB
WA
2 1D
C12
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
2
1
4
2
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 1B
1
9 1J
ABS SOL RELAY
60A FL ABS
1
3
3
B–R
1
ABS MOTOR RELAY
2
3
LG
3
D2
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
5
WB
(Short Pin)
2
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
23
10A GAUGE
R–L
15A ECU–IG
W
GR–R
GR–R
40A
AM1
R–L
1 1K
2 1K
From Cruise Control
ECU<13–2>
From Airbag Sensor
Assembly<14–4>
B–Y
I10
IGNITION SW
4
3
2
8
IJ2
ACC
EC
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
16 CAMRY CNG
P o w e r S ou rc e
K e y R e mind er an d S e at B elt W a rning
1
H orn
4
3
2
B
ACC
2 AM1
B
B–Y
B–R
1 2A
IG1 4
4 1B
1 1K
1
SHORT PIN
10A GAUGE
W
I10
IGNITION SW
25A
DOOR
2
1
1 1D
2 1K
D
L–W
C B
7 C
B–R
B–R
4 A
L–W
B–R
B–R
10 2K
1 1W
7
9
3
1 2F
G–W
1 A
2
1
C
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
10
7 1J
3 1M
5
8
6
5 1M
4 1S
7 1S
G–B
100A
ALT
13 A
HORN
RELAY
G–B
2 F
F 9 A , F11 C , F14 F
1 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
B–R
B
1 C
3 1T
I12 A
INTEGRATION
RELAY
5
R
A A
12 2J
C10 A , C12 C
1 1B
J31 A , J32 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
D
SEAT BELT WARNING
J3
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
R–L
R–W
2
7. 5A DOME
2 1D
40A
AM1
10A
HORN
G–W
6
B–G
B5
BUCKLE SW LH
2
W–B
2
A
A
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
Under the
left center
pillar
BK
See Light Auto
Turn Off System<6–2>
1
1
W–B
U1
UNLOCK WARNING SW
BATTERY
R–Y
L–B
W–B
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
1
1
C14
HORN SW
[COMB. SW]
H3
HORN
(High)
H4
HORN
(Low)
MEMO
1
W
F 9 A , F14 F
B–R
1 A
B–G
BATTERY
FL MAIN
3. 0W
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
B–R
100A
ALT
B–R
2 F
D
10A
GAUGE
B–Y
D
D
2 1D
1 1K
2
Instrument panel
brace RH
BR
R–L
J3
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–L
R–L
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
EC
BR
IG
Intake manifold
3
1
C o mb in atio n M ete r
R–L
2
SE
3
1
IG+
SI
4
L
D
R–L
1 F
F
F
1 1J
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG1 4
ACC
R–L
2 IG2
1 1B
I10
IGNITION SW
2 AM1
R–L
1
2
2 1K
40A
AM1
P o w er S o urc e
17 CAMRY CNG
L
P
Y–G
BR
BR
R–L
F
E
D
C
B
A
(Cont. next page)
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
V1
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(Combination Meter)
P
W3
WATER TEMP. SENDER
Y–G
17 CAMRY CNG (Cont’ d)
C om bination M e ter
5
A
See Interior Light
System<6–4>
R–L
7
R–L
Y–R
To Engine Control
Module<2–7>
C
3
IH1
Y–G
6
IH1
E
7
IH1
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
5
BR
2
Y–G
1
10
A
R
8
A
P
9
A
DOOR
10
B
O/D OFF
12
A
B
FUEL
C
A
WATER
TEMP.
A
B–O
8
C
P
6
C
L
15
B
R–W
7
B
3
A
See Electronically Controlled
Transmission and A/T
Indicator System
<3–3><3–4>
TACHOMETER
(*1)
ILLUMINATION
12
C
14
B
BRAKE
TURN RH
REAR LIGHTS
4
B
See Electronically Controlled
Transmission and A/T Indicator
System<3–3>
See Illumination System
<7–4>
3
IF1
17
IF1
P–L
See Engine Control
System<2–2>
See ABS System<15–2>
EB
Left radiator
side support
2
C
OIL
HIGH BEAM
WASHER LEVEL
CRUISE
4
C
ABS
4
A
SEAT BELT
5
B
See Charging System
<1–4>
W–B
Y–B
5
IH1
10
C
See Headlight
System<4–4>
See Cruise Control
System<13–2>
12
B
SRS
C10 A , C11 B , C12 C
Y–B
8
B
9
B
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR
LAMP
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
See Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning Light
System<5–3>
1
C
B
13
B
1
A
A
W–B
See Key Reminder and Seat Belt
Warning System<16–3>
11
C
BULB
CHECK
RELAY
B
V–W
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
P–L
B–O
2
B
B
V–W
1
B
13
A
CHARGE
See Interior Light
System<6–4>
O1
OIL PRESSURE SW
1
3
IJ2
GR
6
IE1
W–B
P3
PARKING BRAKE SW
R–W
Instrument
panel brace
LH
W1
WASHER LEVEL
WARNING SW
W–B
IF
N
W–B
P–L
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7
A
FUEL
16
B
7 IE1
A
3
BR
See Charging
System<1–4>
From Park/Neutral
Position SW<1–2>
1
G–W
See Taillight
System<8–3>
R–W
B1
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
WARNING SW
2
D
6
B
TURN LH
3
IE2
R–W
B
R–W
1
11
A
V–W
L
2
V–W
P
2
IH1
C
TRIP METER
ODOMETER
F
6
IF1
B–O
6
A
To Cruise Control
ECU<13–4>
From Engine
Control Module
<2–10>
L
To Engine Control
Module<2–10><3–3>
D
BR
BR
11
B
13
C
See Illumination
System<7–4>
B
* 1 : Speedometer
8
7
6
See SRS System
<14–4>
Left kick
panel
IE
COMBINATION METER
M
M OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
18 CAMRY CNG
P o w e r S ou rc e
R ea r W in do w D e fog ge r a nd M irro r H ea ter
1
R a diato r F a n an d C on de ns e r F a n
4
3
2
B–R
B–R
B–Y
B–Y
B–R
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
4 1B
W
B–R
1
2
2
M
1
1 2G
W–R
W–B
W–B
B–R
B–R
W–B
W–B
EB
Left radiator
side support
3
4
1
5
1
1
1
W–B
W–B
W–B
2 EA1
2
W–R
1
1
B–R
1
1
R
5
M
1
FAN NO. 2
RELAY
1
2
R1
RADIATOR
FAN MOTOR
3
G–W
1
FAN NO. 3 RELAY
2
L
L
1
From MG CLT
Relay<19–2>
Instrument
panel brace
LH
1
W4
WATER TEMP.
SW NO. 1
L–W
W–B
W–B
2
2
G–W
B–W
L–W
A
N2
NOISE FILTER
(Rear Window
Defogger)
2 2F 7 2G
A3
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
A
IF
IG
W–B
W–B
J9
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
ID
W–B
4
E
W–B
W–B
W–B
Cowl side
panel LH
2
3
3 1V
II
1 2C
1 EA1
5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
3
G–W
1
7 1G
Right kick
panel
4 2F
8 IB1
D
FL MAIN
3. 0W
2
12 1J
R4
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
W–B
20 ID1
2
3
B
W–B
B–G
20 IL1
BATTERY
B–R
2
Y–G
A
4
FAN NO. 1
RELAY
B
A
1
4
B–R
2 2C
1 1L
J33
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
2 2H
1
3
2
1
W–B
A
2
A1
A/C CONDENSER
FAN MOTOR
5
L–B
DEFOGGER
RELAY
5
2 2B
5
ENGINE MAIN
RELAY
1
W–B
J35
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 A
F 9 A , F12 D , F14 F
100A ALT
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
2 F
A
13 1J
3
1 F
A
L–B
R13
MIRROR HEATER LH
[REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH]
5
A
B–Y
B–R
B–R
B–R
R14
MIRROR HEATER RH
[REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH]
1
B–R
5 ID1
B–Y
To Diode
(Idle–Up)<2–8>
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
5 IL1
6 2K
L–B
B–Y
1 1B
30A
CDS
6 1A
7 1J
J30
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5 1T
1
30A
RDI
W–B
4 1D
B–Y
1
11 1J
1
2
3 1R
B–Y
40A
AM1
15A ECU–IG
10A
MIRROR–
HEATER
2 1K
10A HEATER
1
40A DEF
NOISE FILTER
I10
IGNITION SW
1 D
1 1K
M
19 CAMRY CNG
P o w e r S o urc e
A ir C o nd ition in g
1
3
2
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
L–B
1 1K
W
L–B
G
To Engine Control
Module<2–10>
1
FACE
B/L
9 2C
FOOT
2 1W
2 1K
1
5
B
R–B
D
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
L–R
B
B
BR
OFF
2
5
1
B
IF
OFF
6 IG
W–B
7 GND
A
A
BR
Instrument
panel brace
LH
W–B
W–B
B4
BLOWER SW
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
1
J9
JUNCTION
A CONNECTOR
A
A W–B
BR
LO
6 IG3
A
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
R–W
4
M1
5
DEF
M
L–B
8
M2
4
F/D
To Engine Control
Module<2–10>
L–B
L–O
A
2
R–B
A
3
B/L FOOT
L–R
1
FACE
3
Left radiator
side support
B
R–B
1
3
J30
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
6
B–W
B–G
5
EB
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
D
L–B
2
HI
BATTERY
From Engine Control
Module<2–10>
To Engine
Control Module
<2–10>
L–R
BR
W–L
4
To Engine Control
Module<2–10>
B3
BLOWER RESISTOR
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
FL MAIN
3. 0W
L–Y
W–B
F14 F
To FAN NO. 3
Relay<18–3>
B–W
F 9 A , F13 E ,
B–W
3
EB1
L–R
M
1
1 A
5
1
7
IJ2
L–W
50A HTR
100A ALT
2
B2
BLOWER MOTOR
L–R
B–W
1 E
6
L–O
1
L–Y
L–W
B–R
B–R
2 F
L–R
B–R
1 F
2 EB1
7
DEF
B–L
1
L–R
1 EB2
8
F/D
L–R
1
1
L
1
2
L–W
1
3
B/L FOOT
B–W
1
1 1B
DEF
GND FACE
W–B
3
10 IJ2
L–B
R–B
2
5 2K
L–R
3
1
9 IJ2
F/D
L–B
2
1
10A A/C
4
40A
AM1
2
1
MG CLT RELAY
5
1
1
HTR RELAY
1
L–B
2
1
3 1R
2
BR
L–B
A2
A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AND LOCK SENSOR
4
W–L
L–B
2
IJ2
G
H7
HEATER CONTROL SW
10A HEATER
I10
IGNITION SW
L–B
4
A3
A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
B–Y
B–Y
4
B–W
1
L–B
ON
A15
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
A12
A/C SW
Intake
manifold
EC
FOREWORD
This wiring diagram manual has been prepared to provide
information on the electrical system of the 1999 CAMRY.
Applicable models: MCV20 Series
SXV20 Series
For service specifications and repair procedures of the above
models other than those listed in this manual, refer to the
following manuals;
Manual Name
1999 CAMRY Repair Manual
Volume 1
Volume 2
1999 TOYOTA New Car Features
Pub. No.
RM654U1
RM654U2
NCF160U
All information in this manual is based on the latest product
information at the time of publication. However, specifications
and procedures are subject to change without notice.
NOTICE
When handling supplemental restraint system components (removal,
installation or inspection, etc.), always follow the direction given in the repair
manuals listed above to prevent accidents and supplemental restraint
system malfunction.
A INTRODUCTION
This manual consists of the following 12 sections:
No.
Section
Description
INDEX
Index of the contents of this manual.
INTRODUCTION
Brief explanation of each section.
B
HOW TO USE THIS
MANUAL
Instructions on how to use this manual.
C
TROUBLE–
SHOOTING
Describes the basic inspection procedures for electrical circuits.
D
ABBREVIATIONS
Defines the abbreviations used in this manual.
E
GLOSSARY OF
TERMS AND
SYMBOLS
Defines the symbols and functions of major parts.
F
RELAY LOCATIONS
Shows position of the Electronic Control Unit, Relays, Relay Block, etc.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
G
ELECTRICAL
WIRING ROUTING
Describes position of Parts Connectors, Splice points, Ground points, etc.
This section is closely related to the system circuit.
INDEX
Index of the system circuits.
SYSTEM CIRCUITS
Electrical circuits of each system are shown from the power supply through ground
points. Wiring connections and their positions are shown and classified by code
according to the connection method. (Refer to the section, ”How to use this manual”).
The ”System Outline” and ”Service Hints” useful for troubleshooting are also contained
in this section.
I
GROUND POINTS
Shows ground positions of all parts described in this manual.
J
OVERALL
ELECTRICAL
WIRING DIAGRAM
Provides circuit diagrams showing the circuit connections.
K
POWER SOURCE
(Current Flow Chart)
Describes power distribution from the power supply to various electrical loads.
L
PART NUMBER OF
CONNECTORS
Indicates the part number of the connectors used in this manual.
A
H
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL B
This manual provides information on the electrical circuits installed on vehicles by
dividing them into a circuit for each system.
The actual wiring of each system circuit is shown from the point where the power
source is received from the battery as far as each ground point. (All circuit
diagrams are shown with the switches in the OFF position.)
When troubleshooting any problem, first understand the operation of the circuit
where the problem was detected (see System Circuit section), the power source
supplying power to that circuit (see Power Source section), and the ground points
(see Ground Points section). See the System Outline to understand the circuit
operation.
When the circuit operation is understood, begin troubleshooting of the problem
circuit to isolate the cause. Use Relay Location and Electrical Wiring Routing
sections to find each part, junction block and wiring harness connectors, wiring
harness and wiring harness connectors, splice points, and ground points of each
system circuit. Internal wiring for each junction block is also provided for better
understanding of connection within a junction block.
Wiring related to each system is indicated in each system circuit by arrows
(from__, to__). When overall connections are required, see the Overall Electrical
Wiring Diagram at the end of this manual.
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
∗ The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual
circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
[A]
STOP LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 66)
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
,,,,,,,,,,
[C]
15A
STOP
7. 5A
GAUGE
4
IB
2
1
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
@@@@
ÀÀÀÀ
,,,,
7 3C
[G]
15 3C
R–L
W–R
R (W/G)
3 IB
L (S/D)
[B]
R–L
4
2
C7
REAR LIGHTS
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
14
[E]
IE1
13
1
G–W
[D]
L (S/D)
I5
[F]
G–W
Y–G
G–W
TO ABS ECU
[H]
7
L4
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
8
DELAY
CIRCUIT
[J]
B18
H17
HIGH MOUNTED
STOP LIGHT
[L]
1
W–B
B18
W–B
1
BV1
W–B
W–B
W–B
3
2
BO
50
[N]
[M]
BL
W–B
4
[K]
(SHIELDED)
R6
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
R7
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–R
G–R
G–R
1
BV1
3
11
G
[I]
4
1
G–R
2
4
B
[I]
[A] : System Title
[B] : Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and
only the Relay Block No. is shown to distinguish it
from the J/B
Example :
Indicates Relay Block No.1
: Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B
= Black
W = White
BR = Brown
L
= Blue
V
SB = Sky Blue
= Violet
R = Red
O = Orange LG = Light Green
[C] : (
) is used to indicate different wiring and
connector, etc. when the vehicle model, engine
type, or specification is different.
P
Y
[D] : Indicates related system.
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the
second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
[E] : Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness
connector. The wiring harness with male terminal is
shown with arrows (
).
Outside numerals are pin numbers.
= Pink
= Yellow
G = Green
Example:
L–Y
L
(Blue)
Female
Male (
)
GR = Gray
Y
(Yellow)
[J] : Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are ”E” for the
Engine Room, ”I” for the Instrument Panel, and ”B”
for the Body).
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness
and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component’s location, e.g, ”E” for the Engine
Compartment, ”I” for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and ”B” for the Body and
Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second
letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g, IH1,
IH2), this indicates the same type of wiring harness
and wiring harness connector.
[F] : Represents a part (all parts are shown in sky blue).
The code is the same as the code used in parts
position.
[G] : Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B
No. and the connector code is shown beside it).
Junction Blocks are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts.
Example:
,,,,
,,,,
3C indicates
,,,,
that it is inside
,,,,
Junction Block
,,,,
No.3
,,,,
,,,,
The Location of splice Point I 5 is indicated by the
shaded section.
[K] : Indicates a shielded cable.
[L] : Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and
male connectors.
Example : Numbered in order
from upper left to
lower right
Female
Numbered in order
from upper right to
lower left
Male
[M] : Indicates a ground point.
[H] : When 2 parts both use one connector in common,
the parts connector name used in the wire routing
section is shown in square brackets [
].
The first letter of the code for each ground point(s)
indicates the component’s location, e.g, ”E” for the
Engine Compartment, ”I” for the Instrument Panel
and Surrounding area, and ”B” for the Body and
Surrounding area.
[N] : Page No.
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
[O]
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current is applied at all times through the STOP fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the stop light SW.
When the ignition SW is turned on, current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor, and also flows
through the rear lights warning light to TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor.
STOP LIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
When the ignition SW is turned on and the brake pedal is pressed (Stop light SW on), if the stop light circuit is open, the current
flowing from TERMINAL 7 of the light failure sensor to TERMINALS 1, 2 changes, so the light failure sensor detects the
disconnection and the warning circuit of the light failure sensor is activated.
As a result, the current flows from TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 11 to GROUND and turns the rear lights
warning light on. By pressing the brake pedal, the current flowing to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor keeps the warning
circuit on and holds the warning light on until the ignition SW is turned off.
[P]
SERVICE HINTS
S6 STOP LIGHT SW
2–1 : Closed with the brake pedal depressed
L4 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
1, 2, 7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the stop light SW on
4, 8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
11–GROUND : Always continuity
[Q]
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
See Page
Code
See Page
34
L4
36
R7
37
H17
36
R6
37
S6
35
[R]
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
1
[S]
Code
C7
See Page
18
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
R/B No.1 (Instrument Panel Left)
@@@
ÀÀÀ
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
@@@
ÀÀÀ
,,,
@@@
ÀÀÀ
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
[T]
IB
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
3C
22
Instrument Panel Wire and J/B No.3 (Instrument Panel Left Side)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
[U]
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
42
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
BV1
50
Luggage Room Wire and Floor Wire (Luggage Compartment Left)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
[V]
See Page
Ground Points Location
BL
50
Under the Left Quarter Pillar
BO
50
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
[W]
I5
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
Cowl Wire
B18
C7
H17
See Page
50
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Luggage Room Wire
L4
R6
R7
1 2
4 X
X 7 8 X 11 X
X
X
3
3
6
6
S6
GRAY
4 X
13
1
2
[X]
1
2
B
[O] : Explains the system outline.
[P] : Indicates values or explains the function for reference during troubleshooting.
[Q] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of the parts in the system circuit.
Example : Part ”L4” (Light Failure Sensor) is on page 36 of the manual.
∗ The letter in the code is from the first letter of the part, and the number indicates its order in parts
starting with that letter.
Example : L 4
Á
Á
Parts is 4th in order
Light Failure Sensor
[R] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of Relay Block Connectors in the system circuit.
Example : Connector ”1” is described on page 18 of this manual and is installed on the left side of the instrument
panel.
[S] : Indicates the reference page showing the position on the vehicle of J/B and Wire Harness in the system circuit.
Example : Connector ”3C” connects the Instrument Panel Wire and J/B No.3. It is described on page 22 of this
manual, and is installed on the instrument panel left side.
[T] : Indicates the reference page describing the wiring harness and wiring harness connector (the female wiring
harness is shown first, followed by the male wiring harness).
Example : Connector ”IE1” connects the floor wire (female) and Instrument panel wire (male). It is described on
page 42 of this manual, and is installed on the left side kick panel.
[U] : Indicates the reference page showing the position of the ground points on the vehicle.
Example : Ground point ”BO” is described on page 50 of this manual and is installed on the back panel center.
[V] : Indicates the reference page showing the position of the splice points on the vehicle.
Example : Splice point ”I5” is on the Cowl Wire Harness and is described on page 44 of this manual.
[W]: Indicates connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.) Explanation of pin use.
Pins used in the system circuit.
Occupied positions, but not
applicable to the system circuit.
Unoccupied positions.
The pins shown
[X] : Connector
Colorare only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
HINT :
Junction Connector
Same Color
Short Terminal
Junction connector (code: J1 to J40) in this manual include a short
terminal which is connected to a number of wire harnesses. Always
perform inspection with the short terminal installed. (When
installing the wire harnesses, the harnesses can be connected to
any position within the short terminal grouping. Accordingly, in
other vehicles, the same position in the short terminal may be
connected to a wire harness from a different part.)
Wire harness sharing the same short terminal grouping have the
same color.
B HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
The ground points circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective ground points. When
troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use a common ground may help you identify
the problem ground quickly. The relationship between ground points ( EA , IB and IC shown below) can also be
checked this way.
I GROUND POINT
FAN MAIN RELAY
5
A/C FAN RELAY NO.2
5
A/C FAN RELAY NO.3
5
E3
O/D MAIN SW
E3
CLOCK
W–B
W–B
A
A
A
A
E5
E6
W–B
FRONT SIDE MARKER
LIGHT RH
W–B
FRONT SIDE MARKER
LIGHT LH
W–B
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
WARNING SW
W–B
W–B
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
,,,,
W–B
I4
W–B
2
IA1
B4
COMBINATION METER
W–B
1
3D
W–B
CRUISE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
3
3F
W–B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
13
3G
W–B
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
5 W–B
3E
I2
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
6
3E
I2
LIGHT CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
WIPER AND WASHER
SW [COMB. SW]
W–B
I5
15
ID1
W–B
W–B
I5
W–B
W–B
BLOWER RESISTOR
8
IB1
W–B
I8
W–B
A/C AMPLIFIER
4
4
POWER WINDOW
CONTROL RELAY
B5
DOOR KEY LOCK SW LH
B5
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW
FUEL CONTROL SW
3
IC3
I5
W–B
WOOFER AMPLIFIER
BR
COMBINATION METER
4
BR
BR
4
I3
BR
I3
COMBINATION METER
BR
FUEL SENDER
W–B
4
BR
BR
5
BA1
W–B
AUTO ANTENNA
MOTOR
B5
(4A–GZE)
W–B
HEATER RELAY
POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW
I5
4
W–B
BR
B5
DOOR LOCK MOTOR LH
W–B
4
RADIO AND PLAYER
UNLOCK WARNING
SW
W–B
W–B
HORN SW [COMB. SW]
DIMMER SW
[COMB. SW]
I2
W–B
10 EA2
I4
BLOWER SW
I5
W–B
B4
W–B
I6
W–B
EA
ELECTRICAL IDLE−UP
CUT RELAY (M/T)
HEATER SERVO
MOTOR AMPLIFIER
PARKING BRAKE SW
7 W–B
3C
E4
B4
I6
W–B
7
3B
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
RH
A
E5
E4
W–B HEATER CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
W–B
E4
W–B
DOOR KEY LOCK
SW RH
A
E2
E4
W–B
W–B
E3
W–B
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
RELAY
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
E3
W–B
RETRACT MOTOR LH
PARKING LIGHT LH
W–B
W–B
RETRACT MOTOR RH
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
W–B
W–B
RETRACT CONTROL
RELAY
PARKING LIGHT RH
W–B
W–B
RADIATOR FAN MOTOR
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
W–B
W–B
5
W–B
FAN MAIN RELAY
IB
IC
∗ The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
B
The ”Current Flow Chart” section, describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit breakers)
transmits current to. In the Power Source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery power is supplied to each system
are explained. Since all System Circuit diagrams start from the power source, the power source system must be fully
understood.
K POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
The chart below shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each electrical source
(Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
10A ECU–B
Short Pin
2
2
7.5A DOME
15A EFI
Battery
30A AM2
Fusible Link Block
2
10A HAZARD
6
2
20A RADIO NO.1
Starter
S2
10A HORN
100A ALT
60A ABS
6
5
Engine Room R/B (See Page 20)
Fuse
20A
10A
System
Page
STOP
ABS
ABS and Traction Control
Cruise Control
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
Multiplex Communication System
194
187
180
166
210
DOME
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
Combination Meter
Headlight
Interior Light
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning
Light Auto Turn Off
Theft Deterrent and Door Lock Control
214
230
112
122
POWER SOURCE
40A DOOR LOCK CB
1.25B FL MAIN
W
W
W
2
2
7
EB1
W
W
B
W
B
1
7.5A DOME
I2
50A MAIN
E7
2
W–L
W
W
W
I2
1
1
R
W
I2
1
B
W
1
W
B
2
2
4
W–B
2
B
4
B
B
2
3
2
4
1
2
1
W–B
2
2
3
B–W
1
3
2
G
15A TAIL
1
20A DEFOG
B–Y
1
G
W–R
1
B
2
1
4
I8
IGNITION SW
B–W
STARTER RELAY
E7
8
IG1
3
ACC
2
1
IG2
B
2
1
TAIL
RELAY
INJECTION RELAY
B–O
E7
2
W
15A HAZ–RADIO
AM1
2
6
EB1
W–R
W–R
2
AM2
E7
7.5A AM2
B
G–W
W
BATTERY
3 EA2 1 EA1
W–B
1
1
E6
15A RAD CIG
B–Y
1
P–L
1
∗ The system shown here is an EXAMPLE ONLY. It is different to the actual circuit shown in the SYSTEM CIRCUITS SECTION.
C TROUBLESHOOTING
To Ignition SW
IG Terminal
Fuse
[A]
SW 1
Voltmeter
[B]
VOLTAGE CHECK
(a) Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check
point.
Example:
[A] – Ignition SW on
[B] – Ignition SW and SW 1 on
[C] – Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (SW 2 off)
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground
point or negative battery terminal, and the positive lead to the
connector or component terminal.
This check can be done with a test light instead of a voltmeter.
Relay
[C]
Solenoid
SW 2
CONTINUITY AND RESISTANCE CHECK
(a) Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage
between the check points.
(b) Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check
points.
Ohmmeter
SW
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check
again.
When contacting the negative lead to the diode positive side
and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be
continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no
continuity.
Ohmmeter
Diode
(c) Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V
minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical circuit.
Digital Type
Analog Type
C
To Ignition SW
IG Terminal
Test Light
Fuse Case
Short [A]
SW 1
Short [B]
Disconnect
Disconnect
Light
(a) Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse.
(b) Connect a test light in place of the fuse.
(c) Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example:
[A] – Ignition SW on
[B] – Ignition SW and SW 1 on
[C] – Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on (Connect the
Relay) and SW 2 off (or Disconnect SW 2)
(d) Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the
test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light
stays lit and the connector where the light goes out.
(e) Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the
problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
Relay
Short [C]
Disconnect
SW 2
FINDING A SHORT CIRCUIT
(a) Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless
absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals are touched,
the IC may be destroyed by static electricity.)
(b) When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of
the digital meter, be careful that no part of your body or
clothing comes in contact with the terminals of leads
from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Solenoid
DISCONNECTION OF MALE AND FEMALE
CONNECTORS
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not
the wire harness.
HINT : Check to see what kind of connector you are
disconnecting before pulling apart.
Pull Up
Press Down
Pull Up
Press Down
C TROUBLESHOOTING
HOW TO REPLACE TERMINAL
(with terminal retainer or secondary locking device)
Reference:
1. PREPARE THE SPECIAL TOOL
10
3
1
HINT : To remove the terminal from the connector, please
construct and use the special tool or like object shown on
the left.
2. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
1
0.2
(mm)
3. DISENGAGE THE SECONDARY LOCKING DEVICE OR
Example:
(Case 1)
Up
Tool
TERMINAL RETAINER.
(a) Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal
locking clip can be released and the terminal removed from
the connector.
(b) Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary
locking device or terminal retainer.
NOTICE:
Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Terminal Retainer
[A]
Terminal Retainer
HINT : The needle insertion position varies according to the
connector’s shape (number of terminals etc.), so
check the position before inserting it.
[Retainer at Full Lock Position]
Stopper
”Case 1”
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock
position.
Terminal
Retainer
[Retainer at Temporary Lock Position]
Example:
(Case 2)
For Non–Waterproof Type Connector
Secondary
Locking Device
”Case 2”
Open the secondary locking device.
C
Tool
Tab
Tab
Example:
[B]
Terminal
Retainer
Tool
Male
Access Hole
(
Mark)
Tool
For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT : Terminal retainer color is different
according to connector body.
Example:
Terminal Retainer
Black or White
Black or White
Gray or White
: Connector Body
: Gray
: Dark Gray
: Black
Female
”Case 1”
Type where terminal retainer is pulled
up to the temporary lock position (Pull
Type).
Insert the special tool into the terminal
retainer access hole (Mark) and pull
the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT : The needle insertion position varies
according to the connector’s shape
(Number of terminals etc.), so check
the position before inserting it.
Retainer
at Full Lock Position
Retainer
at Temporary Lock Position
[Male]
[Female]
Example:
(Case 2)
”Case 2”
Type which cannot be pulled as far as
Power Lock insert the tool straight into
the access hole of terminal retainer as
shown.
Terminal Retainer
Tool
Tool
[Male]
Press Down
Press Down
[Female]
C TROUBLESHOOTING
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Retainer at
Full Lock Position
Retainer at
Temporary Lock Position
[Male]
[Female]
(c) Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out
from rear.
Locking Lug
Tool
4. INSTALL TERMINAL TO CONNECTOR
(a) Insert the terminal.
HINT:
1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly.
2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug locks firmly.
3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock
position.
(b) Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to
the full lock position.
5. CONNECT CONNECTOR
ABBREVIATIONS D
ABBREVIATIONS
The following abbreviations are used in this manual.
ABS
=
Anti–Lock Brake System
A/C
=
Air Conditioning
ACIS
=
Acoustic Control Induction System
A/T
=
Automatic Transaxle
COMB. =
Combination
ECU
=
Electronic Control Unit
EGR
=
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ESA
=
Electronic Spark Advance
EVAP
=
Evaporative Emission
FL
=
Fusible Link
J/B
=
Junction Block
LH
=
Left–Hand
M/T
=
Manual Transaxle
O/D
=
Overdrive
R/B
=
Relay Block
RH
=
Right–Hand
SFI
=
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
SRS
=
Supplemental Restraint System
SW
=
Switch
TEMP.
=
Temperature
VSV
=
Vacuum Switching Valve
w/
=
With
w/o
=
Without
∗ The titles given inside the components are the names of the terminals (terminal codes) and are not treated as being
abbreviations.
E GLOSSARY OF TERMS AND SYMBOLS
GROUND
The point at which wiring attaches to
the Body, thereby providing a return
path for an electrical circuit; without a
ground, current cannot flow.
BATTERY
Stores chemical energy and
converts it into electrical energy.
Provides DC current for the auto’s
various electrical circuits.
CAPACITOR (Condenser)
A small holding unit for temporary
storage of electrical voltage.
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
An electric resistance heating
element.
HEADLIGHTS
Current flow causes a headlight
1. SINGLE
filament to heat up and emit light. A
FILAMENT
headlight may have either a single
(1) filament or a double (2) filament
2. DOUBLE
FILAMENT
CIRCUIT BREAKER
Basically a reusable fuse, a circuit
breaker will heat and open if too
much current flows through it.
Some units automatically reset when
cool, others must be manually reset.
HORN
An electric device which sounds a
loud audible signal.
DIODE
A semiconductor which allows
current flow in only one direction.
IGNITION COIL
Converts low–voltage DC current
into high–voltage ignition current for
firing the spark plugs.
DIODE, ZENER
LIGHT
Current flow through a filament
causes the filament to heat up and
emit light.
A diode which allows current flow in one
direction but blocks reverse flow only up
to a specific voltage. Above that potential,
it passes the excess voltage. This acts as
a simple voltage regulator.
PHOTODIODE
The photodiode is a semiconductor
which controls the current flow
according to the amount of light.
LED (LIGHT EMITTING DIODE)
Upon current flow, these diodes emit
light without producing the heat of a
comparable light.
DISTRIBUTOR, IIA
Channels high–voltage current from
the ignition coil to the individual
spark plugs.
METER, ANALOG
Current flow activates a magnetic
coil which causes a needle to move,
thereby providing a relative display
against a background calibration.
FUSE
METER, DIGITAL
Current flow activates one or many
LED’s, LCD’s, or fluorescent
displays, which provide a relative or
digital display.
A thin metal strip which burns through
when too much current flows through it,
thereby stopping current flow and
protecting a circuit from damage.
FUEL
FUSIBLE LINK
(for Medium Current Fuse)
(for High Current Fuse or
Fusible Link)
A heavy–gauge wire placed in high
amperage circuits which burns through on
overloads, thereby protecting the circuit.
The numbers indicate the crosssection
surface area of the wires.
M
MOTOR
A power unit which converts
electrical energy into mechanical
energy, especially rotary motion.
E
RELAY
Basically, an electrically operated
1. NORMALLY switch which may be normally
CLOSED closed (1) or open (2).
Current flow through a small coil
creates a magnetic field which either
opens or closes an attached switch.
SPEAKER
An electromechanical device which
creates sound waves from current
flow.
2. NORMALLY
OPEN
SWITCH, MANUAL
1. NORMALLY
OPEN
RELAY, DOUBLE THROW
A relay which passes current
through one set of contacts or the
other.
Opens and closes
circuits,
i it thereby
th b
stopping (1) or
allowing (2) current
flow.
2. NORMALLY
CLOSED
RESISTOR
An electrical component with a fixed
resistance, placed in a circuit to
reduce voltage to a specific value.
SWITCH, DOUBLE THROW
A switch which continuously passes
current through one set of contacts
or the other.
RESISTOR, TAPPED
A resistor which supplies two or
more different non adjustable
resistance values.
SWITCH, IGNITION
A key operated switch with several
positions which allows various
circuits, particularly the primary
ignition circuit, to become
operational.
RESISTOR, VARIABLE or RHEOSTAT
A controllable resistor with a variable
rate of resistance.
Also called a potentiometer or
rheostat.
SENSOR (Thermistor)
A resistor which varies its resistance
with temperature.
SWITCH, WIPER PARK
Automatically returns wipers to the
stop position when the wiper switch
is turned off.
SENSOR, SPEED
Uses magnetic impulses to open
and close a switch to create a signal
for activation of other components.
TRANSISTOR
A solidstate device typically used as
an electronic relay; stops or passes
current depending on the voltage
applied at ”base”.
(Reed Switch Type)
SHORT PIN
Used to provide an unbroken
connection within a junction block.
SOLENOID
An electromagnetic coil which forms
a magnetic field when current flows,
to move a plunger, etc.
WIRES
Wires are always drawn as
(1) NOT
straight lines on wiring
CONNECTED diagrams.
Crossed wires (1) without a
black dot at the junction
are
j
nott joined;
j i d
crossed wires (2) with a
black dot or octagonal ( )
(2) SPLICED
mark at the junction are
spliced (joined)
connections.
F RELAY LOCATIONS
[Engine Compartment]
[Body]
F
[Instrument Panel]
Fusible Link Block
Engine Compartment Left (See Page 18)
(Inside Engine Room J/B No.2)
F RELAY LOCATIONS
,,,
,,,
,,,: Instrument Panel J/B
Lower Finish Panel (See Page 19)
F
[Instrument Panel J/B Inner Circuit]
F RELAY LOCATIONS
,,,
,,,
,,,: Engine Room J/B No.2 Engine Compartment Left (See Page 18)
F
[Engine Room J/B No.2 Inner Circuit]
F RELAY LOCATIONS
1
Engine Compartment Left (See Page 18)
: Engine Room R/B No.1 (Inside Engine Room J/B No.2)
2
: Engine Room R/B No.2 Near the Battery (See Page 18)
F
3
: Engine Room R/B No.3 Radiator Upper Support RH (See Page 18)
(TMMK Made w/ ABS and Traction Control)
(TMC Made w/ ABS, w/ ABS and Traction Control)
3
: Fusible Link Block
Radiator Upper Support RH (See Page 18)
(TMMK Made w/ ABS w/o Traction Control)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[1MZ–FE]
A 1 A/C Condenser Fan Motor
A 2 A/C Magnetic Clutch and Lock Sensor
A 3 A/C Triple Pressure SW
(A/C Dual and Single Pressure SW)
A 4 ABS Actuator
A 5 ABS Actuator
A 6 ABS Actuator and ECU
A 7 ABS and Traction Actuator
A 8 ABS and Traction Actuator
A 9 ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
A 10 ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
A 28 Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
A 29 Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
A 30 A/C Ambient Temp. Sensor
A 31 Airbag Sensor Front LH
A 32 Airbag Sensor Front RH
B 1 Back–Up Light SW
B 2 Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
C 1 Camshaft Position Sensor
C 2 Crankshaft Position Sensor
C 3 Cruise Control Actuator
D 1 Data Link Connector 1
D 2 Daytime Running Light Resistor
D 3 Diode (A/C)
E
E
E
E
E
1
2
3
5
6
EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
EGR Valve Position Sensor
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
Engine Hood Courtesy SW
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light LH
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light RH
Front Wiper Motor
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
G 1 Generator
G 2 Generator
H
H
H
H
H
H
1
2
3
4
5
6
Headlight LH
Headlight RH
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Horn (High)
Horn (Low)
G
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[1MZ–FE]
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
1
2
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Idle Air Control Valve
Igniter
Ignition Coil No.1
Ignition Coil No.2
Ignition Coil No.3
Injector No.1
Injector No.2
Injector No.3
Injector No.4
Injector No.5
Injector No.6
K 1 Knock Sensor 1
K 2 Knock Sensor 2
M 2 Mass Air Flow Meter
N 1 Noise Filter (Ignition)
O 1 Oil Pressure SW
P 1 Park/Neutral Position SW,A/T Indicator Light SW and
Back–Up Light SW
P 2 Power Steering Oil Pressure SW
R 1 Radiator Fan Motor
S 1 Starter
S 2 Starter
T 1 Theft Deterrent Horn
T 2 Throttle Position Sensor
V 2 Vehicle Speed Sensor (Combination Meter)
V 3 Vehicle Speed Sensor
(Electronically Controlled Transmission)
V 4 VSV (EGR)
V 5 VSV (EVAP)
V 6 VSV (Intake Air Control)
W
W
W
W
W
1
2
3
4
5
Washer Level Warning SW
Washer Motor
Water Temp. Sender
Water Temp. SW No.1
Water Temp. SW No.2
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[5S–FE]
A 1 A/C Condenser Fan Motor
A 2 A/C Magnetic Clutch and Lock Sensor
A 3 A/C Triple Pressure SW
(A/C Dual and Single Pressure SW)
A 4 ABS Actuator
A 5 ABS Actuator
A 6 ABS Actuator and ECU
A 9 ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
A 10 ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
A 11 Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
A 31 Airbag Sensor Front LH
A 32 Airbag Sensor Front RH
B 1 Back–Up Light SW
B 2 Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
C 1 Camshaft Position Sensor
C 2 Crankshaft Position Sensor
C 3 Cruise Control Actuator
D 1 Data Link Connector 1
D 2 Daytime Running Light Resistor
E
E
E
E
3
4
5
6
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
Engine Hood Courtesy SW
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light LH
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light RH
Front Wiper Motor
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
Fusible Link Block
G 1 Generator
G 2 Generator
H
H
H
H
H
1
2
3
5
6
Headlight LH
Headlight RH
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Horn (High)
Horn (Low)
G
Position of Parts in Engine Compartment
[5S–FE]
I 1 Idle Air Control Valve
I 3 Ignition Coil and Igniter No.1
I 4 Ignition Coil and Igniter No.2
I 8 Injector No.1
I 9 Injector No.2
I 10 Injector No.3
I 11 Injector No.4
I 14 Intake Air Temp. Sensor
K 1 Knock Sensor 1
R 1 Radiator Fan Motor
S 1 Starter
S 2 Starter
T 1 Theft Deterrent Horn
T 2 Throttle Position Sensor
V 2 Vehicle Speed Sensor (Combination Meter)
V 4 VSV (EGR)
V 5 VSV (EVAP)
M 1 Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
N 1 Noise Filter (Ignition)
O 1 Oil Pressure SW
P 1 Park/Neutral Position SW,A/T Indicator Light SW and
Back–Up Light SW
P 2 Power Steering Oil Pressure SW
W
W
W
W
1
2
3
4
Washer Level Warning SW
Washer Motor
Water Temp. Sender
Water Temp. SW No.1
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
22
23
24
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
A/C Amplifier
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
A/C SW
ABS and Traction ECU
ABS and Traction ECU
ABS and Traction ECU
ABS ECU
ABS ECU
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
Airbag Squib (Front Passenger Airbag Assembly)
Airbag Squib (Steering Wheel Pad)
Ashtray Illumination
A/C Blower Motor Linear Controller
A/C Control Assembly
A/C Control Assembly
A/C Room Temp. Sensor
A/C Solar Sensor
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
Automatic Light Control Sensor
B
B
B
B
3
4
5
8
Blower Motor
Blower Resistor
Blower SW
Blower Resistor (Low Speed)
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Cigarette Lighter
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
Clock
Clutch Start SW
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
Combination Meter
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
11
12
13
14
15
17
18
19
Combination SW
Combination SW
Combination SW
Cruise Control Clutch SW
Cruise Control ECU
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
D
D
D
D
D
D
4
5
6
7
10
11
Data Link Connector 2
Data Link Connector 3
Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
Diode (Courtesy)
Diode (Dome)
Diode (Idle–Up)
E
E
E
E
E
7
8
9
10
11
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
Engine Control Module
G 3 Glove Box Light and SW
H 7 Hazard SW
H 8 Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
H 9 Heater Control SW
I
I
I
I
15
16
17
18
Ignition Key Cylinder Light
Ignition SW
Integration Relay
Integration Relay
G
Position of Parts in Instrument Panel
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
J
J
J
J
34
35
36
37
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
Junction Connector
K 3 Key Interlock Solenoid
O 2 O/D Main SW and A/T Shift Lever Illumination
P 3 Parking Brake SW
P 4 Power Outlet
R
R
R
R
R
R
2
3
4
5
6
7
Radio and Player
Radio and Player
Radio and Player
Rear Window Defogger SW
Remote Control Mirror SW
Rheostat
S
S
S
S
3
4
5
6
Shift Lock ECU
Stereo Component Amplifier
Stereo Component Amplifier
Stop Light SW
T
T
T
T
T
3
4
5
6
7
Theft Deterrent ECU
Theft Deterrent ECU
Traction Off SW
Turn Signal Flasher
Transponder Key Amplifier
U 1 Unlock Warning SW
W 6 Wireless Door Lock ECU
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Body
B 6 Buckle SW LH
F 10
F 11
F 12
F 13
F 14
C16 Condenser
H10 High Mounted Stop Light
D12
D13
D14
D15
D16
D17
D18
D19
D20
D21
D22
I 19 Interior Light
A 25 ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
A 26 ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
A 27 Auto Antenna Motor and Relay
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front RH
Door Lock Control SW RH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW Front LH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW Front RH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW Rear LH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock Detection SW Rear RH
Front Door Speaker LH
Front Door Speaker RH
Front Tweeter (Speaker) LH
Front Tweeter (Speaker) RH
Fuel Pump and Sender
J 38 Junction Connector
J 39 Junction Connector
J 40 Junction Connector
L
L
L
L
L
L
1
2
3
4
5
6
License Plate Light LH
License Plate Light RH
Light Failure Sensor
Luggage Compartment Key Unlock SW
Luggage Compartment Light
Luggage Compartment Light SW
G
Position of Parts in Body
M 3 Moon Roof Control SW and Relay
M 4 Moon Roof Motor and Limit SW
N 2 Noise Filter (Rear Window Defogger)
P 5
P 6
P 7
P 8
P 9
P 10
P 11
P 12
P 13
P 24
P 25
Personal Light
Power Window Control SW Front RH
Power Window Control SW Rear LH
Power Window Control SW Rear RH
Power Window Master SW and Door Lock Control SW LH
Power Window Motor Front LH
Power Window Motor Front RH
Power Window Motor Rear LH
Power Window Motor Rear RH
Pretensioner LH
Pretensioner RH
R 8
R 9
R10
R 11
R12
R13
R14
R15
R16
R17
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light LH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Combination Light RH
Rear Speaker LH
Rear Speaker RH
Rear Window Defogger
Rear Window Defogger
Remote Control Mirror LH
Remote Control Mirror RH
S 7 Side Airbag Sensor LH
S 8 Side Airbag Sensor RH
V
V
V
V
1
7
8
9
Vapor Pressure Sensor
VSV (Vapor Pressure Sensor)
Vanity Light LH
Vanity Light RH
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
Position of Parts in Seat
B 7 Buckle SW LH
P 14
P 15
P 16
P 17
P 18
P 19
P 20
Power Seat Control SW (Driver’s Seat)
Power Seat Control SW (Front Passenger’s Seat)
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Rear Vertical Control)
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Reclining Control)
Power Seat Motor (Driver’s Seat Slide Control)
Power Seat Motors (Driver’s Seat)
Power Seat Motor
(Front Passenger’s Seat Rear Vertical Control)
P 21 Power Seat Motor
(Front Passenger’s Seat Reclining Control)
P 22 Power Seat Motor (Front Passenger’s Seat Slide Control)
P 23 Power Seat Motors (Front Passenger’s Seat)
S 9 Side Airbag Squib LH
S 10 Side Airbag Squib RH
MEMO
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[1MZ–FE]
: Location of Splice Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
EA1
DARK GRAY
2 1
1 2
(w/o Daytime Running Light)
ES1
EB1
EB1
(w/ Daytime Running Light)
1 2 3 4
4
3
2
1
5 6 7 8
8
7
6
5
GRAY
EB2
1 2 3 4
4
3
2
1
5 6 X X
X X
6
5
1
BLACK
1
1
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EA1
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room Main No.3 Wire (Radiator LH)
EB1
EB2
GRAY
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
No 2)
EC1
Engine Wire and Sensor Wire (Head Cover RH)
ES1
Engine Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
GRAY
1
EC1
1 2
3 4
DARK GRAY
2 1
4 3
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
[5S–FE]
: Location of Splice Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
EA1
1 2
DARK GRAY
(w/ Daytime Running Light)
2 1
(w/o Daytime Running Light)
EB1
EB1
1 2 3 4
4
3
2
1
5 6 7 8
8
7
6
5
EB2
GRAY
1 2 3 4
4
3
2
1
5 6 X X
X
X
6
5
1
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EA1
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room Main No.3 Wire (Radiator LH)
EB1
EB2
GRAY
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
No 2)
GRAY
1
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
ID1
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE2
Front Door LH Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
IF2
IG1
IG2
IG3
IH1
IH2
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel No.2
No 2 Wire (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Splice Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
II1
II2
II3
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
II4
IJ1
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK1
IK2
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire ((Right
g Kick Panel))
IK3
IL1
IM1
IM2
IN1
IN2
Floor No.2 Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
Floor No
No.2
2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IT1
Cowl Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IU1
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Ground Points
: Location of Splice Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
BO1
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
BP1
2
1
7 6 5 4 3
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
BO1
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
2
1
7 6 5 4 3
G ELECTRICAL WIRING ROUTING
: Location of Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
: Location of Splice Points
G
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
BQ1
BV1
BR1
YELLOW
1 2
1 2 3
3 2 1
BW1
1 2
2 1
2 1
YELLOW
2 1
1 2
Code
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
BQ1
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Driver’s Seat)
BR1
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Passenger’s Seat)
BV1
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Driver’s Seat)
BW1
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Passenger’s Seat)
POWER SOURCE
5
2
G1
GENERATOR
B–W
1
2
(* 6)
3
B
2
2
(* 6)
W–B
2
GR
(* 6)
A/F HTR RELAY
60A FL ABS
B
1
B–G
1
3
(*7, *2 * 4)
R–L
ABS SOL RELAY
6
4
3
5
3
2
1
3
60A FL ABS
B–G
1
3
2
W–L
3
2
(* 2 * 5)
GR–R
3
W–B
3
1
2
4
3
W–R
3
GR–R
L
(*6)
L
3
GR–L
3
3
ABS MOTOR RELAY
B–R
W–B
1
4
2
3
1
B–R
L–R
1
5
(* 3)
1
1
1
100A
ALT
25A A/F HTR
1 A
1 C
50A
HTR
1 D
4
2F
W–B
5
2C
W–B
6
2K
15A EFI
10A HAZARD
20A RADIO NO. 1
10A HORN
4
2L
30A AM2
1
B–R
B–G
SHORT PIN
10A ECU–B
2
W–B
1
W–R
(* 6)
1
2A
5A ALT–S
7. 5A DOME
R
40A MAIN
B
BATTERY
3
2B
1
HEAD RELAY
2
1
2
3
5
4
3
2
1
ST RELAY
(* 8)
3
2G
(*9)
FL MAIN 3. 0W
B
R–B
W
5
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
B–R
1
FL 1. 25B
2
W–B
1
F7 D , F8 E , F9 F
L–B
1 E
3
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
B–R
2 F
1
2
30A CDS
F4 A , F5 B , F6 C ,
B–R
1 F
1
2
30A RDI
4
2
2B
2
(* 3)
HTR RELAY
E3
1 B
L–R
1
10A A/C
L–B
1
2
W–B
B–G
1
1
L–W
(* 2 * 5)
B–G
(*7, *2 * 4)
B–G
(5S–FE W/O ABS)
(* 6)
L
L–B
4
2G
R–L
(* 8)
15A HEAD (RH)(* 9)
15A HEAD RH(UPR)(* 8)
15A HEAD (LH)(* 9)
15A HEAD LH(UPR)(* 8)
EB
B–R
4
1B
5
3
1
2
10A TAIL
25A DOOR
7. 5A PANEL
15A STOP
TAILLIGHT RELAY
7. 5A OBD
30A POWER
1
POWER RELAY
5
3
2
1
2
NOISE FILTER
1
2
B–R
NOISE FILTER
1
2
I1
40A DEF
1
2
7
1J
W–B
DEFOGGER RELAY
5
3
10A MIRROR–HEATER
B–R
1
1B
W
2
1K
1
1
2
2
40A AM1
15A CIG
7. 5A RAD–NO. 2
2 AM1
ACC 3
L–R
IG1 4
B–Y
6
1K
1
1K
15A POWER–OUTLET
15A ECU–IG
10A HEATER
10A GAUGE
7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
ST2 8
R
25A WIPER
7. 5A TURN
3
1K
4
1K
5
1K
5
1B
6
1A
I16
IGNITION SW
W–R
W–R
B–R
5A IGN
5A STARTER
5A DRL NO. 2
R
1
2
(*8)
2
2
W–R
1
2
4
2
DIM
RELAY
3
2
2
2
R–B
2
1
2
2
R–G
R–L(* 8)
R–Y
10A H–LP LH (LWR)
1
3
2
R
W–B
R
10A H–LP RH (LWR)
R–L
(*8)
A
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMMK MADE
* 3 : EXCEPT TAIWAN
* 4 : W/ TRACTION CONTROL
* 5 : W/O TRACTION CONTROL
* 6 : CALIFORNIA
* 7 : TMC MADE EXCEPT 5S–FE W/O ABS
* 8 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 9 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
POWER SOURCE
SERVICE HINTS
HEAD RELAY [ENGINE ROOM J/B NO.2]
2–1 : Closed with the light control SW at HEAD position or the dimmer SW at FLASH position
Closed with the engine running and the parking brake pedal released (Parking brake SW off) (w/ Daytime Running
Light)
TAILLIGHT RELAY [INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B]
5–3 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
I16 IGNITION SW
2–3 : Closed with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
2–4 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
7–6 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
7–8 : Closed with the ignition SW at ST position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
F4
See Page
26 (1MZ–FE)
A
F5
F6
F7
28 (5S–FE)
26 (1MZ–FE)
B
F8
28 (5S–FE)
26 (1MZ–FE)
C
Code
F9
28 (5S–FE)
See Page
D
E
F
Code
26 (1MZ–FE)
G1
28 (5S–FE)
See Page
26 (1MZ–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
26 (1MZ–FE)
I16
30
28 (5S–FE)
J11
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
See Page
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
1
24
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
2
24
Engine Room R/B No.2 (Near the Battery)
3
25
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Radiator Upper Support RH)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1A
1B
1J
20
Cowl Wire and J/B Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1K
2A
2B
2C
2F
2G
2K
2L
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
IG
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
40
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
I1
See Page
42
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
F4 (A)
F5 (B)
F6 (C)
1
F9 (F)
F7 (D)
1
F8 (E)
1
G1
1
I16
1
J11
ORANGE
1
1
A
2
A
X
2
3
4
X
6
7
8
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
STARTING AND IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
ACC
AM1
IG1
ST1
7 AM2
3
1K
B–R
IG2 6
ST2 8
8
1C
B–R
W–R
R
B–W
4 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
5 1K
5A
STARTER
B–W
B
B–W
11
2
5
30A
AM2
40A
MAIN
ST
RELAY
1
3
2
3 2B
5 2D
9 2K
2
5
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
P
11 2J
N
6
GR
B–O
(* 2 M/T)
GR
II2
B–G
C B
B–O
GR(*1 A/T)
1 A
(*2 A/T)
B–R
10
W–B
F4 A , F6 C
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
GR(* 1)
B–O(* 2)
1 C
(* 1 M/T)
B
B
(A/T)
1 2A
1
II2
1
B–W
C7
CLUTCH START SW
4 2L
(A/T)
B–W
(M/T)
W–R
3 1J
(A/T)
B–W
5 1B
C B
J7 A ,
J8 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B A
B A
GR(*1)
FL MAIN
3. 0W
B–O(*2)
1 A
1
B
W–B
B–R
B–O(*2)
M
BATTERY
S1 B , S2 A
STARTER
GR(* 1)
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
IG
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMMK MADE
B–R
12
II3
B–R
B–W
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
A
B–R
B–R
1
1
2
G
2
Y
2
2
1
10
IGC3
IGC2
I2
IGNITER
9
+B
3
GR
GND
7
BR–Y
IGT1
6
LG–B
IGT2
5
W–R
IGT3
B–W
IGF
4
BR
IGC1
20 B
25 E
13 E
12 E
11 E
NSW
B–R
B–R
1
A
B–R
A
I5
IGNITION COIL NO. 1
A
I6
IGNITION COIL NO. 2
A
L
I7
IGNITION COIL NO. 3
A
IGF
IGT3
IGT2
IGT1
STA
1
N1
NOISE FILTER
(IGNITION)
E 7 A , E 8 B , E11 E
7 A
B–O(* 2)
GR(*1)
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
2
BR
GR(*1)
B–O(* 2)
BR
ED
STARTING AND IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
SERVICE HINTS
I16 IGNITION SW
7–6 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
7–8 : Closed with the ignition SW at ST position
P1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
5–6 : Closed with the A/T shift lever in P or N position (A/T)
S1 (B), S2 (A) STARTER
Points closed with the Park/Neutral position SW at P or N position and the ignition SW at ST position (A/T)
Points closed with the clutch start SW on and the ignition SW at ST position (M/T)
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C7
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
30
I5
27 (1MZ–FE)
J18
31
E7
A
30
I6
27 (1MZ–FE)
J29
31
E8
B
30
I7
27 (1MZ–FE)
N1
27 (1MZ–FE)
E11
E
30
I16
30
P1
F4
A
26 (1MZ–FE)
J7
A
31
S1
B
27 (1MZ–FE)
F6
C
26 (1MZ–FE)
J8
B
31
S2
A
27 (1MZ–FE)
I2
27 (1MZ–FE)
J11
27 (1MZ–FE)
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
1C
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
22
Cowl Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
1K
2A
2B
2D
2J
2K
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
II2
II3
See Page
42
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
ED
36 (1MZ–FE)
Rear Side of the Surge Tank
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
E7 (A)
C7
E8 (B)
E11 (E)
(California)
1 2
X X
7
X X X
X
X
X X
X X X X X
11 12 13
20 X
X 25
X
X X X
E11 (E)
F4 (A)
F6 (C)
(Except California) BLACK
1
1
X
11 12 13
X 25
I2
I5
I6
I7
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
X
I16
2
1
2
1
9 10
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
GRAY
GRAY
B B B
C C C
J11
A
X
X
6
7
8
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J18
(Hint : See Page 7)
J29
ORANGE
B B B B
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
S1 (B)
2
S2 (A)
BLACK
1
1
N1
P1
GRAY
GRAY
1 2
X
5
6
STARTING AND IGNITION (5S–FE)
ACC
AM1
IG1
ST1
7 AM2
B–R
IG2 6
ST2 8
13
II3
B–R
B–W
W–R
R
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
4 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
B–R
5 1K
B–W
B
B–W
B–W
4 2L
2
5
30A
AM2
40A
MAIN
1
II2
B–W
C7
CLUTCH START SW
11
1
(A/T)
W–R
3 1J
(M/T)
B–W
5 1B
(A/T)
5A
STARTER
2
ST
RELAY
5
P
1 2A
1
3
2
3 2B
5 2D
9 2K
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
N
11 2J
GR
B–G
1 A
C B
B–O
GR(*3 A/T)
II2
(*4 A/T)
B–O
(* 4 M/T)
GR
GR(* 3)
B–O(* 4)
B–R
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
10
W–B
F4 A , F6 C
(* 3 M/T)
B
1 C
(A/T)
6
B
C B
J7 A ,
J8 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B A
B A
GR(*3)
FL MAIN
3. 0W
B–O(*4)
1 A
1
B
W–B
B–R
B–O(*4)
M
BATTERY
S1 B , S2 A
STARTER
GR(*3)
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
IG
* 1 : W/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 2 : W/O ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 3 : TMC MADE
* 4 : TMMK MADE
J25
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B
B
B–R
B
B–R
B
B–R
1
1
3
4
3
2
W–R
Y–R
GND
4
B–W
2
BR
IGF
W–R
GND
B
IGT
I4
IGNITION COIL
AND IGNITER
NO. 2
IGT
N1
NOISE FILTER
(IGNITION)
+B
I3
IGNITION COIL
AND IGNITER
NO. 1
IGF
BR
+B
B–R
B–W
A
A
A
W–R
22 A
22 A
NSW
23 C
20 C
17 C
3 C
IGT1
IGF
BR
W–R
I2
22 C (*1)
19 C (*2)
IGT2
STA
11 A (*1)
11 A (*2)
E7 A , E9 C
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
GR(* 3)
BR
B–O(* 4)
EC
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
STARTING AND IGNITION (5S–FE)
SERVICE HINTS
I16 IGNITION SW
7–6 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON or ST position
7–8 : Closed with the ignition SW at ST position
P1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
5–6 : Closed with the A/T shift lever in P or N position (A/T)
S1 (B), S2 (A) STARTER
Points closed with the Park/Neutral position SW at P or N position and the ignition SW at ST position (A/T)
Points closed with the clutch start SW on and the ignition SW at ST position (M/T)
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C7
Code
30
See Page
I16
Code
30
See Page
N1
29 (5S–FE)
E7
A
30
J7
A
31
E9
C
30
J8
B
31
S1
P1
B
29 (5S–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
F4
A
28 (5S–FE)
J11
31
S2
A
29 (5S–FE)
F6
C
28 (5S–FE)
J19
31
I3
29 (5S–FE)
J25
31
I4
29 (5S–FE)
J29
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
22
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
22
Cowl Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
1K
2A
2B
2D
2J
2K
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
II2
II3
See Page
42
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EC
38 (5S–FE)
Surge Tank RH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I2
See Page
42
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
E7 (A)
E7 (A)
(w/ Engine Immobiliser System)
(w/o Engine Immobiliser System)
11
X 11
X
22
22
X 17 X 22 23
C7
1 2
E9 (C)
F4 (A)
E9 (C)
(w/ Engine Immobiliser System) DARK GRAY
F6 (C)
I3
GRAY
(w/o Engine Immobiliser System)
1
1
3
1 2 3 4
X 19 20
I4
I16
BLACK
1 2 3 4
X
X
6
7
8
J11
J19
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
GRAY
GRAY
B B B
C C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J25
J29
A A A
A A A
B
B B B
B B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
GRAY
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
N1
P1
GRAY
GRAY
S1 (B)
S2 (A)
BLACK
BLACK
1
1 X
X
5
6
1
CHARGING
B–G
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
B–Y
ST1
7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
W
W–R
ST2
2 1K
5 1K
3 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
2
1 1K
5A
IGN
10A
GAUGE
* 1 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 2 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
40A
AM1
2 1J
B–R
8 1T
4 B
5A
ALT–S
Y
30A
AM2
Y
C
C
C
Y
100A ALT
Y
(* 1)
(*1)
1 C
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
2 F
Y
B–R
1 F
(* 2)
B–R
1 B
W
B–G
1 2A
(*1)
4 IG2
E3
R–L
C8 A , C9 B
3 2C
B–R
4 2L
13 A
TO DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
5 1B
W–R
1 1B
CHARGE WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
1
6 EB1
4 IK2
F6 C , F9 F
R–L
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
G1 B , G2 A
3 A 1 A 2 A
FL MAIN
3. 0W
B–G
F4 A , F5 B ,
Y
B–G
1 A
S
L
IG
BATTERY
IC REGULATOR
1 B
B
GENERATOR
SERVICE HINTS
G2 (A) GENERATOR
(A) 3–GROUND : 13.9–15.1 volts with the engine running at 2000 rpm and 25C (77F)
13.5–14.3 volts with the engine running at 5000 rpm and 115C (239F)
(A) 1–GROUND : 0–4 volts with the ignition SW at ON position and the engine not running
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C8
A
30
C9
B
30
F4
F5
F6
26 (1MZ–FE)
A
F9
28 (5S–FE)
26 (1MZ–FE)
B
Code
G1
28 (5S–FE)
See Page
C
F
B
Code
26 (1MZ–FE)
G2
28 (5S–FE)
See Page
A
26 (1MZ–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
26 (1MZ–FE)
I16
30
28 (5S–FE)
J1
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1K
1T
2A
2C
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
EB1
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
No 2)
IG2
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
IK2
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
E3
See Page
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
CHARGING
C8 (A)
C8 (A)
(TMC Made) BLUE
(TMMK Made) BLUE
13
13
C9 (B)
C9 (B)
F4 (A)
(TMC Made)
1
4
F5 (B)
4
F6 (C)
F9 (F)
G1 (B)
G2 (A)
ORANGE
1
1
1
1
I16
J1
X
2
4
X
6
7
BLACK
C C
C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
2
1
2
3
MEMO
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
B(* 1)
R
B–R
8 1C
(* 1)
B–W
5
1
3
2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 2A
B–R
3
1
1
5 EB1
4 EB1
I1
7 ID1
L–B
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
2
(* 1)
II3
B–R
12
W–B
2
30A
AM2
5
J35 A , J36 B
2
B–W
4 2L
4 1K
2
A/F HTR RELAY
2
C
A
B–R
5A IGN
L
5A STARTER
W–R
5 1B
(* 1)
1
1
L–B
7 1W
1
L–B
3 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
C
A
1
CIR OPN RELAY
3 1J
A
B
2
B–R
G–R
B
(*1)
ST2 8
B–R
B–W
25A
A/F
HTR
B–R
R
5 1K
1
B–R
IG2 6
W–R
7 AM2
B–W
7
IK1
G–R
1
ES1
B–R
B
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
(*1)
B–W
B–W
A
A
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
B–R
A
4
F14
FUEL
PUMP
M
5
G–R
W–B
I13
INJECTOR NO. 6
A
I12
INJECTOR NO. 5
A
I11
INJECTOR NO. 4
A
I10
INJECTOR NO. 3
A
I9
INJECTOR NO. 2
1 A
I8
INJECTOR NO. 1
F4 A , F6 C
B–R
1
(* 1)
G
R–L
W
Y
L
B–G
W–B
R
FL MAIN
3. 0W
G
R–L
W
BATTERY
Y
R
L
W–B
1 C
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
B
B–W
A
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BL
B(*1)
B(* 1)
B–W
B–Y
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
B–Y
B–W
B–Y
9
II3
B–W
B–R
B–W
C7
CLUTCH START
SW
2
5
P
N
C B
C B
GR
(* 5 A/T)
10
II2
J7 A ,
J8 B
V
B–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–Y
(A/T)
6
2
GR(*4 A/T)
B–Y
10 ID1
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
(M/T)
B–W
1
GR(*4 M/T)
B–Y
B–Y
1
B–O(* 5 M/T)
B B
B–Y
B–R
B–W
B–O
B–Y
J27 A , J28 B
B–Y
E A
V7
VSV (VAPOR
PRESSURE SENSOR)
B B
4 2F 10 2C
W–B
W–B
E A
2
2J
B B
5 2C
B A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
B A
11
II2
(A/T)
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–Y
B–Y
B
B
B–Y
5
EFI RELAY
2
B–W
8
2J
7 2K
1
B
(A/T)
15A
EFI
B A
B–W
B–O
B–Y
1 ID1
(* 5)
V
B–W
GR
(*4)
16 A
8 A
+B
G–R
3 FC
A
B–R
2
A
9 A
MREL
TPC
20 B
7 A
1 A
BATT
STA
NSW
E7 A , E8 B , E9 C ,
G
TRC–
L
20 A
(* 2)
13 A
(* 2)
21 A
LG
14 A
(* 2)
4 C
B
5 D
(* 2)
6 D
W
1 E
(* 2)
16 B
2 E
(* 3)
10 C
3 E
(* 3)
5 C
BR–W
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
NEO
EFI+
EFI–
TRC+
RXCK
L–Y
TXCT
CODE
R–L
# 10
(* 3)
# 20
G–W
# 30
L
# 40
R
4 E
(*1)
# 50
Y
# 60
W
IGSW
R–L
W–B
E10 D , E11 E
G
R–L
W
Y
R
TO TRANSPONDER
KEY AMPLIFIER
L
B–Y
W–B
EB
FROM ABS AND
TRACTION ECU
* 1 : CALIFORNIA
* 2 : W/ TRACTION CONTROL
* 3 : W/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 4 : TMC MADE
* 5 : TMMK MADE
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
B(*1)
B(* 1)
B–Y
B–Y
J20
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
A
B–Y
A
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
A
A
A
A
B–Y
BR
10A
MIRROR–
HEATER
H3
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
BR
(* 6)
(* 6)
E1
HT
OX
1
3
L–B(* 6)
(SHIELDED)
Y–G
R–Y
G–W
2
4
+B
7 D
3 D
W
B–Y
2
1
G–O
V5
VSV (EVAP)
V4
VSV (EGR)
2
2
(*6)
B–Y
1
B–Y
B–Y
1
LG
B–Y
A
C B
V6
VSV (INTAKE AIR CONTROL)
A A
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J27 A , J28 B
2
A
1
5 1R
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
4 1R
G–W
7 1C
G–W
11 1J
(* 6)
G–O
9 1C
15A
STOP
W
10A
TAIL
E7 A , E8 B , E9 C ,
E10 D , E11 E
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
15 A
ELS2
VG
E2G
THA
19 D
L–Y
22 D
R–B
10 D
5
3
1
TO IGNITER
18 E
ACIS
P
25 E
W–R
IGF
13 E
LG–B
IGT3
12 E
BR–Y
IGT2
11 E
GR
IGT1
17 E
STP
EGR
EVP1
B–Y
2
OXR1
KSW
11 C
8
IG3
L–B
L–B
M2
MASS AIR
FLOW METER
4
11 D
HTR
B B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
18 A
J 9 A , J10 B
19 A
ELS
B A
BR
BR
2
1
L–B
5
1M
7
1D
L–B
W–B
3
1M
7
1J
W–B
B–Y
A
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
U1
UNLOCK WARNING SW
B(*1)
BR(* 6)
BR
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–Y
B–Y
(SHIELDED)
A
A
BR(* 6)
BR
A
B–Y
BR(* 6)
BR
(*6)
OX
3
BR(* 6)
12 D
16 E
4 D
OXL1
HTL
RSO
*
*
*
*
P–B
Y–B
R–W
(*6)
B
(*6)
Y–R
I2
15 E
3
9 B
RSC
HTS
THG
THW
13 D
14 D
BR(* 1)
1
B–R(* 1)
BR(* 6)
(SHIELDED)
4
I2
B–R(* 1 *5)
I2
2
R(* 1 * 4)
HT
1
(* 1)
BR
E1
1 : CALIFORNIA
4 : TMC MADE
5 : TMMK MADE
6 : EXCEPT CALIFORNIA
8 B
3 D
OXS
11 D
20 D
AFR–
3
4
+B
BR(* 1 * 5)
1
B
G(* 1 *4)
HT
1
2
B(* 1)
AFR+
OX
3
II1
A28
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
B
+B
2
2
BR(* 1)
B
E1
B
(SHIELDED)
2
H8
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL VALVE
4
(* 6)
BR
(* 6)
H4
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(SHIELDED) (BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
B–Y
B–Y
(*6)
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B(*1)
(SHIELDED)
I2
B–Y
BR
HAFR
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D , E11 E
1
3
Y
2
3
E2
1
VTA
4
II1
CF
G–W
J10 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 ID1
VC
6
BR
T2
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
D
B
D
B
VCC
BR
BR
I2
Y
Y
Y
3
II1
Y
5
ID1
II2
IND T 3
THEFT
DETERRENT
ECU
B–L
R–Y
2
E2
I2
G–W
P
1
PTNK
9 D
1
P2
POWER STEERING
OIL PRESSURE SW
I2
4 IG3
R–Y
1
6 ID1
PS
29 E
16 C
FROM FAN NO. 1 RELAY
I2
17 A
R–Y
BR
BR
BR
1
Y
BR
1
2
IMLD
PTNK
V1
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
2
BR
I2
2
BR
Y
L
BR
3
E2
EGR VALVE
POSITION SENSOR
G–Y
W–G
22 E
P
EGLS
2 D
BR
VC
23 D
E5
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
VTA1
E1
EGR GAS TEMP. SENSOR
E2
18 D
G–B
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
BR(* 6)
BR(* 6)
BR
BR
B–Y
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
BR(* 6)
BR(* 6)
BR(* 6)
BR(* 6)
BR(* 1)
BR(* 1)
A29
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
B(*1)
B(* 1)
BR(* 1)
BR
4
21 D
B–W
B–R
TE1
8
I2
(SHIELDED)
E1
(SHIELDED)
I2
L
L–W
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
L(* 1 *5)
B–W(*1 * 4)
B–W(*1 * 5)
12 D
AFL–
4 D
HAFL
AFL+
L(* 1 *4)
(SHIELDED)
+B
L
3
I2
C1
CAMSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
2
1
BR
12
C2
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
1
2
BR
3
BR
BR
B–Y
1
BR
BR(*1)
2
B–W(* 1)
BR(* 1)
6 E
TC
16 D
24 D
NE+
NE–
10 E
G22+
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D , E11 E
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
KNKL
KNKR
28 E
TW
14 B
27 E
ACT
A/C
13 B
25 B
TACH
27 B
BR
BR
B–O
B–O
B–O
B–Y
F A
3 EC1
1
B–O
W
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
K1
KNOCK SENSOR 1
K2
KNOCK SENSOR 2
W
(SHIELDED)
D B
14 B
1
TW
10 B
7 C
ACT
13 B
1 C
AC1
J27 A , J28 B
1 EC1
LG–B
V(* 8)
(SHIELDED)
W
(SHIELDED)
2 EC1
F A
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
4 EC1
(SHIELDED)
W
(SHIELDED)
I2
16 A (*8)
4 C (*7)
IGN
A12 C
A/C AMPLIFIER
A34 A , A35 B
A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
BR(* 6)
BR(*7)
BR
BR
BR
BR
I2
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
A
BR(* 6)
BR(*6)
A
BR(* 6)
BR(*6)
A
BR(* 1)
BR(*1)
A
BR(* 1)
BR(*1)
A
BR
BR
A
BR
BR
A
BR
A
A
BR
A
A
* 1 : CALIFORNIA
* 4 : TMC MADE
* 5 : TMMK MADE
* 6 : EXCEPT CALIFORNIA
* 7 : MANUAL A/C
* 8 : AUTOMATIC A/C
A
BR
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
(* 5 M/T)
A
BR
6 A
SIL
W
BR
(* 6)
BR
11 A
EOM
(* 1)
13 C
ADJ2
BR
W
24 E
E1
V–W
BR
BR
17 D
G–R
(*5 M/T)
BR
W
22 B
SPD
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D , E11 E
E01
E02
E03
21 E
31 E
30 E
1 D
BR
BR
BR
BR
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
E04
E05
8 D
BR
BR
(* 1)
(* 1)
B–O
B
B
B
BR
(*1)
BR
J26
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
(* 1)
B
B–O
BR
(* 6)
EC
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
BR
7. 5A
OBD
(SHIELDED)
10A
GAUGE
D
F
B
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J28 B
D
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
B
5
16
SG
BAT
SIL
CG
7
4
3
IG3
V–W
C 9 B , C10 C
COMBINATION METER
7 C
14 B
15 B
6 C
V–W
D5
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
(SHIELDED)
W
B
B
II2
V–W
R–L
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
SPEEDOMETER
2
V–W
TACHOMETER
G–R
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
W–B
(SHIELDED)
W
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
R–L
R–L
BR
I5
BR
C A
2 1D
BR
C A
J8 B
B B
J7 A ,
B B
1 1J
R–L
BR
BR
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
10 1J
R–L
BR
6
II3
B
BR
I3
8 C
2 C
5 C
2
IJ1
3
2
SI
SE
IG+
BR
L
IJ1
P
7
V2
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION METER)
W–B
R–L
8 1J
7 1J
P
10 IG3
L
6 IG3
A
W–B
A A
G–R
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
A
J8 B
B–O
J7 A ,
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–O
A B
BR
R–L
1
B–O
A
ED
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IH
SYSTEM OUTLINE
This system utilizes an engine control module and maintains overall control of the engine, transmission and so on. An outline
of the engine control is explained here.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) Engine coolant temp. signal circuit
The engine coolant temp. sensor detects the engine coolant temp. and has a built–in thermistor with a resistance which
varies according to the water temp. is input into TERMINAL THW of the engine control module as a control signal.
(2) Intake air temp. signal circuit
The intake air temp. sensor is installed in the mass air flow meter and detects the intake air temp., which is input as a
control signal into TERMINAL THA of the engine control module.
(3) Oxygen sensor signal circuit
The oxygen density in the exhaust gases is detected and input as a control signal into TERMINALS OXL1, OXR1
(Except California) and OXS of the engine control module. To maintain stable detection performance by the heated
oxygen sensor, a heater is used for warming the sensor. The heater is also controlled by the engine control module
(HTL, HTR (Except California) and HTS).
(4) RPM signal circuit
Camshaft position and crankshaft position are detected by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
The camshaft position is input as a control signal to TERMINAL G22+ of the engine control module, and the engine
RPM is input into TERMINAL NE+.
(5) Throttle signal circuit
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve opening angle as a control signal, which is input into TERMINAL
VTA1 of the engine control module.
(6) Vehicle speed signal circuit
The vehicle speed sensor, installed inside the transmission, detects the vehicle speed and inputs a control signal into
TERMINAL SPD of the engine control module.
(7) Park/Neutral position SW signal circuit
The Park/Neutral position SW detects whether the shift position is in neutral, parking or not, and inputs a control signal
into TERMINAL STA of the engine control module.
(8) A/C SW signal circuit
The A/C control assembly (Automatic A/C) or A/C Amplifier (Manual A/C) inputs the A/C operations into TERMINAL A/C
of the engine control module as a control signal.
(9) Battery signal circuit
(California or w/ engine immobiliser and/or traction control)
Voltage is always supplies to TERMINAL BATT of the engine control module.
If you turn on the ignition SW, the current goes from TERMINAL MREL of the engine control module to the EFI relay and
put on the relay, and the voltage related to the engine control module operation is supplied to TERMINAL +B of the
engine control module through the EFI relay.
(Except California or w/ engine immobiliser and/or traction control)
Voltage is constantly applied to TERMINAL BATT of the engine control module. When the ignition SW is turned on,
voltage for engine control module start–up power supply is applied to TERMINAL +B of engine control module via EFI
relay.
(10) Intake air volume signal circuit
Intake air volume is detected by the mass air flow meter and a signal is input into TERMINAL VG of the engine control
module as a control signal.
(11) NSW signal circuit
To confirm whether the engine is cranking, the voltage applied to the starter motor during cranking is detected and the
signal is input into TERMINAL NSW of the engine control module as a control signal.
(12) Engine knock signal circuit
Engine knocking is detected by the knock sensor 1 and 2, then the signals are input into TERMINALS KNKR and KNKL
of the engine control module as a control signal.
(13) Air fuel ratio signal circuit (California)
The air fuel ratio is detected and input as a control signal into TERMINALS AFL+, AFR+ of the engine control module.
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
2. CONTROL SYSTEM
∗ SFI system
The SFI system monitors the engine condition through the signals, which are input from each sensor (Input signals (1) to
(12) ). The best fuel injection volume is decided based on this data and the program memorized by the engine control
module, and the control signal is output to TERMINALS #10, #20, #30, #40, #50 and #60 of the engine control module
to operate the injector (Inject the fuel). The SFI system produces control of fuel injection operation by the engine control
module in response to the driving conditions.
∗ ESA system
The ESA system monitors the engine condition through the signals, which are input to the engine control module from
each sensor (Input signals from 1, 3, 4, 12). The best ignition timing is decided according to this data and the memorized
data in the engine control module and the control signal is output to TERMINALS IGT1, IGT2 and IGT3. This signal
controls the igniter to provide the best ignition timing for the driving conditions.
∗ Heated oxygen sensor heater control system
The heated oxygen sensor heater control system turns the heater on when the intake air volume is low (Temp. of
exhaust emissions is low), and warms up the heated oxygen sensor to improve detection performance of the sensor.
The engine control module evaluates the signals from each sensor (Input signals from 1, 4, 9, 10), current is output to
TERMINALS HTL, HTR and HTS, controlling the heater.
∗ Idle air control system
The idle air control system (Rotary solenoid type) increases the RPM and provides idle stability for fast idle–up when the
engine is cold, and when the idle speed has dropped due to electrical load and so on, the engine control module
evaluates the signals from each sensor (Input signals from 1, 4, 5, 8, 9), current is output to TERMINALS RSO and RSC
to control idle air control valve.
∗ EGR control system
The EGR control system detects the signal from each sensor (Input signals from 1, 4, 9, 10), and outputs current to
TERMINAL EGR to control the VSV (EGR).
The EGR valve position sensor is mounted on the EGR valve. this sensor converts the EGR valve opening height into a
voltage and sends it to the engine control module as the EGR valve position signal.
∗ ACIS
ACIS includes a valve in the bulkhead separating the surge tank into two parts. This valve is opened and closed in
accordance with the driving conditions to control the intake manifold length in two stages for increased engine output in
all ranges from low to high speeds.
The engine control module judges the engine speed by the signals ( (4), (5) ) from each sensor and outputs signals to
the TERMINAL ACIS to control the VSV (Intake air control).
3. DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
With the diagnosis system, when there is a malfunction in the engine control module signal system, the malfunctioning
system is recorded in the memory.
4. FAIL–SAFE SYSTEM
When a malfunction occurs in any systems, if there is a possibility of engine trouble being caused by continued control
based on the signals from that system, the fail–safe system either controls the system by using data (Standard values)
recorded in the engine control module memory or else stops the engine.
SERVICE HINTS
E5 ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
1–2 : Approx. 15.04 kΩ (–20C, –4F)
Approx. 5.74 kΩ (0C, 32F)
Approx. 2.45 kΩ (20C, 68F)
Approx. 1.15 kΩ (40C, 104F)
Approx. 0.584 kΩ (60C, 140F)
Approx. 0.318 kΩ (80C, 176F)
E7 (A), E8 (B), E9 (C), E10 (D), E11 (E) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
Voltage at engine control module wiring connector
BATT–E1 : Always 9.0–14.0 volts
+B–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
VC–E2 : Always 4.5–5.5 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
VTA1–E2 : 0.3–0.8 volts (Ignition SW on and throttle valve fully closed)
: 3.2–4.9 volts (Ignition SW on and throttle valve fully open)
VG–E2G : 1.1–1.5 volts (Engine idling and A/C SW OFF position)
THA–E2 : 0.5–3.4 volts (Engine idling and intake air temp. 20°C, 68°F)
THW–E2 : 0.2–1.0 volts (Engine idling and engine coolant temp. 80°C, 176°F)
IGF–E1 : 4.5–5.5 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
Pulse generation (Engine idling)
G22+–NE– : Pulse generation (Engine idling)
NE+–NE– : Pulse generation (Engine idling)
NSW–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW on and other shift position in P or N position)
Below 3.0 volts (Ignition SW on and shift position in P or N position)
SPD–E1 : Pulse generation (Ignition SW on and rotate driving wheel slowly)
TC–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON Position)
W–E1 : Below 3.0 volts
A/C–E1 : Below 2.0 volts (Engine idling and A/C SW on)
9.0–14.0 volts (A/C SW off)
ACT–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Engine idling and A/C SW on)
Below 2.0 volts (A/C SW off)
ACIS–E01 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
STA–E1 : 6.0 volts or more (Engine cranking)
THG–E2 : 4.5–5.5 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
ELS–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts (Taillight SW at ON position)
0–1.5 volts (Taillight SW at OFF position)
ELS2–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts (Defogger SW at ON position)
0–1.5 volts (Defogger SW at OFF position)
EGR–E01 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
FC–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
0–3.0 volts (Engine idling)
EVP1–E01 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
CF–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Electric cooling fan is operating on high speed)
0–2.0 volts (Electric cooling fan is operating on low speed or off)
TACH–E1 : Pulse generation (Engine idling)
TPC–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW on and disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor)
PTNK–E1 : 3.0–3.6 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
1.3–2.1 volts (Ignition SW on and apply vacuum 2.0 kpa (15.0 mmHg, 0.6 in.Hg)
STP–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts (Ignition SW on and brake pedal depressed)
Below 1.5 volts (Ignition SW on and brake pedal released)
SIL–E1 : Pulse generation (During transmission)
RSC, RSO–E01 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW on and disconnect E 7 of engine control module connector)
KNKL, KNKR–E1 : Pulse generation (Engine idling)
HTS, HTL, HTR–E03 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
0–3.0 volts (Engine idling)
OXS, OXL, OXR–E1 : Pulse generation (Maintain engine speed at 2500 rpm for two minutes after warning up)
IGT1, IGT2, IGT3–E1 : Pulse generation (Engine idling)
#10, #20, #30, #40, #50, #60–E01 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
Pulse generation (Engine idling)
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
I8, I9, I10, I11, I12, I13 INJECTOR
2–1 : Approx. 13.8 Ω
CIR OPN RELAY [R/B NO.1]
3–5 : Closed with starter running
EFI RELAY [ENGINE ROOM J/B NO.2]
3–5 : Closed with ignition SW at ON or ST position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
A12
See Page
C
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
30
H8
30
A28
26 (1MZ–FE)
H3
26 (1MZ–FE)
A29
26 (1MZ–FE)
H4
26 (1MZ–FE)
J27
A
31
J28
B
31
A34
A
30
I1
27 (1MZ–FE)
A35
B
30
I8
27 (1MZ–FE)
J24
31
J26
31
J29
31
C1
26 (1MZ–FE)
I9
27 (1MZ–FE)
J35
A
31
C2
26 (1MZ–FE)
I10
27 (1MZ–FE)
J26
B
31
C7
30
I11
27 (1MZ–FE)
J40
32
C9
B
30
I12
27 (1MZ–FE)
K1
27 (1MZ–FE)
C10
C
30
I13
27 (1MZ–FE)
K2
27 (1MZ–FE)
D1
26 (1MZ–FE)
I16
30
M2
27 (1MZ–FE)
D5
30
J3
31
P1
27 (1MZ–FE)
E1
26 (1MZ–FE)
31
P2
27 (1MZ–FE)
E2
26 (1MZ–FE)
J7
A
31
S6
31
E5
26 (1MZ–FE)
J8
B
31
T2
27 (1MZ–FE)
J4
E7
A
30
J9
A
31
T3
31
E8
B
30
J10
B
31
U1
31
E9
C
30
J11
31
V1
27 (1MZ–FE)
E10
D
30
J12
31
V2
27 (1MZ–FE)
E11
E
30
J15
31
V4
27 (1MZ–FE)
F4
A
26 (1MZ–FE)
J18
31
V5
27 (1MZ–FE)
F6
C
26 (1MZ–FE)
J20
31
V6
27 (1MZ–FE)
32
J22
31
V7
27 (1MZ–FE)
F14
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
See Page
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
1
24
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
2
24
Engine Room R/B No.2 (Near the Battery)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1B
1C
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
22
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
22
Cowl Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
1J
1K
1M
1R
1W
2A
2C
2F
2J
2K
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
EB1
36 (1MZ–FE)
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
EC1
36 (1MZ–FE)
Engine Wire and Sensor Wire (Head Cover RH)
ES1
36 (1MZ–FE)
Engine Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
ID1
40
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
IJ1
42
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK3
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
II1
II2
II3
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
36 (1MZ–FE)
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
36 (1MZ–FE)
Surge Tank RH
ED
36 (1MZ–FE)
Rear Side of the Surge Tank
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
I1
42
Cowl Wire
I3
I2
42
Engine Wire
I5
See Page
42
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
A12 (C)
A28
A29
ORANGE
DARK GRAY
DARK GRAY
1 X
4 X
7 X
A35 (B)
X
A34 (A)
1
2
1
2
3
4
3
4
C1
C2
BLACK
BLACK
1 2
1 2
X
16 X X X X
C7
1 2
10 X X 13 14 X
C9 (B)
C9 (B)
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
14 15
C10 (C)
C10 (C)
(TMC Made) BROWN
2 5 6
7 8
(TMMK Made) BROWN
2 5 6
7 8
D5
D1
BLACK
X X 3
X
X 8 X
12 X X
X
14 15
E1
DARK GRAY
X
X
X
X
X
X
1 2
X
16 X X X X X X X
X 7 X 5 4 X X X
E2
E5
BLACK
DARK GRAY
E7 (A)
E9 (C)
1 2
1 2 3
X 8 9
X X X 4 5 X
8 9 X 11 X 13 14 15
X 13 14 X 16 X X X
X X X 10 11 X
16 17
20 X 22
1 2 3 X X
E10 (D)
X X X
6 7
18 19 20 21 X
E10 (D)
(California)
1 2
E8 (B)
E11 (E)
(Except California) BLACK
3 4 5 6 7
X 2
(California)
3 4 5 6 7
1 2
3 4 X 6
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 X 16
X 9 10 11 12 13 14 X 16
10 11 12 13 15 16 17 18 21
17 18 19 20 21
17 18 19 X X
22 X 24 25
22 23 24
22 23 24
F4 (A)
E11 (E)
13 X X
X 25 X 27 X
27 28
29 30 31
F6 (C)
F14
(Except California) BLACK
1
1
3 4 X 6
1 2
4
5
10 11 12 13 15 16 17 18 21
22 X 24 25
27 28
29 30 31
H3
H4
H8
I1
I8
I9
DARK GRAY
DARK GRAY
DARK GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
12
12
1
2
1
2
1
2
3
4
3
4
3
4
1 2 3
I10
I11
I12
I13
GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
12
12
12
12
I16
X
X
6
7
8
16 X
ENGINE CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
J4
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J3
X X
DD DX
C C
C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J9 (A)
J10 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
J11
J12
BLACK
A
B B
B B
D D D
A
A A A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J15
J18
BLACK
ORANGE
B B
B
J20
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
J22
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J24
J26
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
A A B B
B B C C
E E F F
D D E E F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
B
B B B
A
B
A A B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J29
J35 (A)
J36 (B)
B B B B
C C
A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
K1
J40
K2
DARK GRAY
DARK GRAY
1
1
(Hint : See Page 7)
M2
P1
P2
BLACK
GRAY
BLACK
1 2 3 4 5
X
5
6
1
S6
T2
BLUE
BLACK
T3
X X X X 6
2
V1
BLACK
1 2 3
1
U1
1 2
1
2
3
X
V2
V4
V5
V6
V7
BLACK
BROWN
BLUE
BROWN
BLUE
1 2 3
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE)
R
B–R
B–R
I1
(* 2)
(* 2)
B–W
B–R
B–R
R
(*1)
W–R
ST2 8
B–R
I3
(* 1)
B–R
7 1W
B–R
3 1K
7
IK1
B–R
I16
IGNITION SW
(* 2)
B–R
IG2 6
(* 2)
B–R
7 AM2
(* 1)
5 1K
5A
IGN
1
1
5
W–R
5 1B
1
CIR OPN
RELAY
8 1C
B–R
4 2L
2
4 EB1
B–R
B–R
2
2
2
2
L–B
1
I11
INJECTOR NO. 4
1
I10
INJECTOR NO. 3
I9
INJECTOR NO. 2
1
L–B
B–R
7 ID1
G–R
B
(* 1)
B
B–W
B
B–R
I8
INJECTOR NO. 1
B–G
1 A
II4
B
B
F4 A , F6 C
L–B
6
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
5 EB1
B
1 2A
1 C
1
G–R
(* 1)
B–R
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
(* 1)
1
B–W
II3
B–R
12
30A
AM2
3
4
M
1
F14
FUEL
PUMP
W
Y
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
R
L
5
G–R
B–W(*1)
B–R(*1)
W
Y
BATTERY
R
W–B
L
B–R
A
BL
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
B–Y
FROM POWER SOURCE
SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
4 1K
B–R
B–Y
5A STARTER
(*2)
B–W
(A/T)
8
2J
2
B–O
(*4 M/T)
C B
12 A
12 A
(A/T)
GR(*3)
#40
#30
#20
#10
9 C
24 C
10 C
25 C
11 C
11 C
12 C
12 C
23 C
20 C
17 C
3 C
L
B
W–R
STA
R
NSW
Y
(*1)
B–R
(*1)
1 A
11 A (*1)
11 A (*2)
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
W
BATT
IGSW
7 D
B–W
MREL
G–R
FC
14 A
14 A
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D
22 A (*1)
22 A (*2)
2 A
1 A
+B
C B
B A
B–Y
B–Y
W–B
B–Y
1
C7
CLUTCH START SW
B–W
J27 A , J28 B
B B
B–W
(M/T)
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B–Y
B A
E B
GR(* 3 M/T)
(A/T)
B
B–O
B–Y
B A
B–W
J7 A ,
B
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
II2
(*4 A/T)
10
4 2F 10 2C
E A
(A/T)
GR
B–Y
E3
GR
B–Y
B–Y
W–B
N
II2
B–O
2
2J
3
E A
11
6
B
5 2C
II3
IGT1
IGF
G–R
IGT2
22 C (*1)
19 C (*2)
Y–R
B–R
EFI
RELAY
2
9
3 1J
(*3 A/T)
5
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
B–W
1
P
(*4)
7 2K
5
J8 B
15A
EFI
(*1)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–W
2
IGF
IGT
+B
GND
+B
GND
L
13
II3
B–R
4
J25
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
B
1
4
A
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
B
A
W–B
B–R
B–Y
* 1 : W/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 2 : W/O ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
EB
* 3 : TMC MADE
* 4 : TMMK MADE
BR
W–B
B–R
1
BR
R
B–R
Y
BR
IGF
I4
IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER NO. 2
W–R
3
IGT
B–R
W
3
2
I3
IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER NO. 1
B–R(*1)
W–R
I2
B–W(* 1)
EC
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE)
B
B–Y
B
B
B
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B–Y
B–Y
B
B–Y(* 6)
BR
V–W
BR
AF–
4
(* 5)
W(*4)
(* 5)
L(* 3)
(* 5)
O(*4)
2 C
2 C
(*5)
12 B
13 B
I2
V
G(*5)
P–B
3 C
22 C
HT
1
W
B–O
15 B
23 C
AF+
I2
(SHIELDED)
W
V
6 C
9 C
3
+B
B–W(*3)
BR
1
7 C
10 C
II4
(*5)
B
2
3
2
(SHIELDED)
1
1
1 ID1
5
A11
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
B–Y
1
K1
KNOCK SENSOR 1
2
2
2
V5
VSV (EVAP)
1
V4
VSV (EGR)
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL VALVE
V7
VSV
(VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
V
B–Y
10 ID1
B–Y
B–Y
BR
16 B
8 B
TPC
ISCO
ISCC
EGR
EVP
KNK
6 B (* 1)
6 B (* 2)
14 B
14 B
HTAF
AF–
AF+
BR
3
1
PTNK
VCC
E2
V1
VAPOR PRESSURE
SENSOR
BR
I6
BR
3
II2
T2
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
Y
2
2
ID1
BR
P
BR
2
Y
I2
BR
I2
1
3
VC
1
BR
2
VTA
BR
1
E2
E2
3
VC
2
PIM
M1
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
2
1
E5
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
Y
G–B
7
II4
4 B (* 1)
4 B (* 2)
BR
Y
THW
I14
INTAKE AIR TEMP. SENSOR
5
ID1
3 B
3 B
Y–B
Y
THA
2 B
2 B
BR
P
PIM
BR
8
II4
9 B
9 B
B–Y
P
E2
10 B
11 B
BR
6
ID1
VTA
Y
P
VC
1 B
1 B
BR
8 B
7 B
LG
PTNK
Y
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
I2
BR
B–Y
B–Y
* 1 : W/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 2 : W/O ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
B–Y
* 5 : CALIFORNIA
* 6 : EXCEPT CALIFORNIA
* 3 : TMC MADE
* 4 : TMMK MADE
BR
B–Y(*6)
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
(* 6)
TE1
8
2
10A
MIRROR–
HEATER
10A TAIL
1
2
9 1C
1
11 1J
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–O
BR
E1
C1
CAMSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
HT
1
3
+B
BR
OX
3
12
C2
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
E1
B–Y
4
+B
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
BR
(* 6)
(* 6)
2
B–Y
A
G–O
B–W
L
BR
B–R
I2
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
L–W
(*6)
L–Y
(SHIELDED)
W
A
(*6)
H3
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
B–Y
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
3
1
I2
L
B–R
2
5 B
6 B
1 C
8 C
OX1
HT1
7 B
15 B
12 D
4 C
6 D
17 C
TE1
NE+
NE–
D11
DIODE
(IDLE–UP)
13 A (*1)
2 A (*2)
11 D
5 C
G+
ELS
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
B–Y
2 IK2
L–R
L–B
9
II4
1
A13
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
8 IG3
L–B
G
IK2
TO UNLOCK
WARNING SW
J10
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
9
W–L
R–Y
D
TO TRANSPONDER
KEY AMPLIFIER
FROM A/C
MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
R–Y
D
L–Y
6
4 IG3
4 C (* 1)
12 B (* 2)
II2
B–L
II3
L–W
10
THR PS SW
11 B
10 B
1
2
BR
L–Y
4 D
W–L
G–W
KSW
LOCK IN
19 C
18 C
L–B
IK2
TXCT
9 D
R–L
G
7
CODE
8 D
W–L
R–Y
IND
II4
RXCK
3 D
P2
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SW
BR
2
3
PRS
19 A
13 A
FROM
A/C DUAL
PRESSURE SW
A14
A/C SW
H9
HEATER CONTROL SW
5
R–B
B
T3
THEFT DETERRENT
ECU
B
1
MGC
21 A
21 A
R–Y
J12
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–B
R–B
R–W
IMLD
1 D
L–Y
A/C SW
10 A
10 A
FROM MG
CLT RELAY
LOCK
20 A
15 A
1
B–Y
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE)
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
(*6)
BR
B–Y
II2
BR
12
4
+B
HT
OX
H8
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
G–R
3
(SHIELDED)
13 B
5 B
HT2
OX2
8 A
9 A
4 A
5 A
SPD
W
G–R
14 C
21 C
V–W
II3
B
1
P–B
II3
W
B
P–B
1
2
V–W
2
E1
W
6 A (* 1)
16 A (* 2)
SIL
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D
E02
E03
13 C
13 C
26 C
26 C
25 C
16 B
7 A
8 A
A
BR
A
BR
J23
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BR
A
BR
A
A
BR
BR
B–O
STP
9 A (* 1)
4 A (* 2)
BR
BR
A
BR
BR
BR
TACH
G–W
E01
15 C
15 C
BR
BR
A
BR A
E04
BR
E1
24 C
14 C
(* 5)
EOM
2 D
BR
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
(*6)
B–Y
BR
EC
EC
BR
BR
BR
G–W
BR
I2
B–O
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
7. 5A
OBD
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
15A
STOP
7 1C
1 1J
2 1D
R–L
10 1J
10A
GAUGE
R–L
B
W
D
D
3
IG3
V–W
(SHIELDED)
15 B
6 C
SPEEDOMETER
TACHOMETER
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
R–L
BR
G–R
5 C
P
G–R
10 IG3
L
B–O
2 C
6 IG3
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
8 1J
4 1R
7 1J
5 1R
R–L
BR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8 C
A
W–B
J8 B
B–O
A A
B B
II2
R–L
W–B
A B
2
G–R
BR
C A
COMBINATION METER
1
G–W
CG
4
C A
J7 A ,
14 B
C 9 B , C10 C
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
BAT
J8 B
SG
5
7 C
2
16
J7 A ,
SIL
J28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
7
F
B
BR
I5
D5
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
(SHIELDED)
W
J3
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
C
C
V–W
G–R
R–L
R–L
V–W
W
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
7
IJ1
2
IJ1
L
BR
I3
P
(SHIELDED)
J27 A , J28 B
C B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
A A
BR
F A
B–O
J27 A
II3
G–W
6
V2
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION METER)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
F A
2
SI
SE
IG+
1
R–L
G–W
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
* 1 : W/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 2 : W/O ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 5 : CALIFORNIA
* 6 : EXCEPT CALIFORNIA
BR
B–O
IH
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
This system utilizes an engine control module and maintains overall control of the engine, transmission and so on. An outline
of the engine control is explained here.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) Engine coolant temp. signal circuit
The engine coolant temp. sensor detects the engine coolant temp. and has a built–in thermistor with a resistance which
varies according to the engine coolant temp. thus the engine coolant temp. is input in the form of a control signal into
TERMINAL THW of the engine control module.
(2) Intake air temp. signal circuit
The intake air temp. sensor detects the intake air temp., which is input as a control signal into TERMINAL THA of the
engine control module.
(3) Oxygen sensor signal circuit
The oxygen density in the exhaust gases is detected and input as a control signal into TERMINAL OX1 (except
California) and OX2 of the engine control module.
(4) RPM signal circuit
Camshaft position and crankshaft position are detected by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Camshaft position is input as a control signal to TERMINAL G+ of the engine control module, and engine RPM is input
into TERMINAL NE+.
(5) Throttle signal circuit
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve opening angle, which is input as a control signal into TERMINAL
VTA of the engine control module.
(6) Vehicle speed signal circuit
The vehicle speed sensor, installed inside the transmission, detects the vehicle speed and inputs a control signal into
TERMINAL SPD of the engine control module.
(7) Park/Neutral position SW signal circuit (A/T)
The Park/Neutral position SW detects whether the shift position are in neutral, parking or not, and inputs a control signal
into TERMINAL STA of the engine control module.
(8) A/C SW signal circuit
The A/C amplifier function is built in the engine control module. The A/C SW signal inputs into the TERMINAL A/C SW of
the engine control module.
(9) Battery signal circuit
Voltage is constantly applied to TERMINAL BATT of the engine control module. When the ignition SW is turned on, the
voltage for engine control module start–up power supply is applied to TERMINAL +B of engine control module via EFI
relay.
(10) Intake air volume signal circuit
Intake air volume is detected by the manifold absolute pressure sensor (for manifold pressure) and is input as a control
signal into TERMINAL PIN of the engine control module.
(11) Starter signal circuit
To confirm whether the engine is cranking, the voltage applied to the starter motor during cranking is detected and the
signal is input into TERMINAL NSW of the engine control module as a control signal.
(12) Engine knock signal circuit
Engine knocking is detected by knock sensor 1 and the signal is input into TERMINAL KNK as a control signal.
(13) Electrical load signal circuit
The signal when systems such as the rear window defogger, headlights, etc. Which cause a high electrical burden are
on is input to TERMINAL ELS as a control signal.
(14) Air fuel ratio signal circuit (California)
The air fuel ratio is detected and input as a control signal into TERMINAL AF+ of the engine control module.
2. CONTROL SYSTEM
∗ SFI system
The SFI system monitors the engine condition through the signals, which are input from each sensor (Input signals from
(1) to (14) etc.) to the engine control module. The best fuel injection volume is decided based on this data and the
program memorized by the engine control module, and the control signal is output to TERMINALS #10, #20, #30 and
#40 of the engine control module to operate the injector. (Inject the fuel). The SFI system produces control of fuel
injection operation by the engine control module in response to the driving conditions.
∗ ESA system
The ESA system monitors the engine condition through the signals, which are input to the engine control module from
each sensor (Input signals from (1), (2), (4) to (12) etc.) the best ignition timing is detected according to this data and the
memorized data in the engine control module, and the control signal is output to TERMINALS IGT1 and IGT2. This
signal controls the igniter to provide the best ignition timing for the driving conditions.
∗ Idle Air Control system
The IAC system (Step motor type) increases the RPM and provides idling stability for fast idle–up when the engine is
cold and when the idle speed has dropped due to electrical load, etc. The engine control module evaluates the signals
from each sensor (Input signals (1), (4) to (8), (13) etc.), outputs current to TERMINALS ISCO and ISCC, and controls
the idle air control valve.
∗ Fuel pump control system
The engine control module operation outputs to TERMINAL FC and controls the CIR OPN relay. Thus controls the fuel
pump drive speed in response to conditions.
∗ EGR control system
The EGR cut control system controls the VSV (EGR) by evaluating the signals from each sensor which are input to the
engine control module (Input signals (1), (5), (6), (9) etc.) and by sending output to TERMINAL EGR of the engine
control module.
∗ A/C conditioning operation system
In addition to the conventional A/C cut control, the engine control module performs the air conditioning operation as well
since the A/C amplifier function is built in it.
3. DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
With the diagnosis system, when there is a malfunctioning in the engine control module signal system, the malfunction
system is recorded in the memory. The malfunctioning system can then be found by reading the display (Code) of the
malfunction indicator lamp.
4. FAIL–SAFE SYSTEM
When a malfunction occurs in any system, if there is a possibility of engine trouble being caused by continued control based
on the signals from that system, the fail–safe system either controls the system by using data (Standard values) recorded in
the engine control module memory or else stops the engine.
SERVICE HINTS
E7 (A), E8 (B), E9 (C), E10 (D) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
Voltage at engine control module wiring connector
BATT–E1 : Always 9.0–14.0 volts
+B–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
VC–E2 : 4.5– 5.5 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
VTA–E2 : 0.3– 0.8 volts (Ignition SW on and throttle valve fully closed)
3.2–4.9 volts (Ignition SW on and throttle valve open)
PIM–E2 : 3.3– 3.9 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
THA–E2 : 0.5–3.4 volts (Ignition SW on and intake air temp. 20°C, 68°F)
THW–E2 : 0.2– 1.0 volts (Ignition SW on and coolant temp. 80°C, 176°F)
STA–E1 : 6.0–14.0 volts (Engine cranking)
W–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (No trouble and engine running)
TE1–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
NSW–E1 : 0– 3.0 volts (Ignition SW on and Park/Neutral position SW position P or N position)
9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW on and except Park/Neutral position SW position P or N position)
IGT1, IGT2–E1 : Pulse generation (Engine cranking or idling)
#10, #20, #30, #40–E01, E02 : 9.0–14.0 volts (Ignition SW at ON position)
RESISTANCE AT ENGINE CONTROL MODULE WIRING CONNECTORS
(Disconnect wiring connector)
VC–E2 : 2.5–5.0 kΩ
THA–E2 : 2.21–2.69 kΩ (Intake air temp. 20°C, 68°F)
THW–E2 : 0.29–0.354 kΩ (Coolant temp. 80°C, 176°F)
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE)
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A11
28 (5S–FE)
H8
30
J21
31
A13
30
H9
30
J23
31
A14
30
I1
29 (5S–FE)
J25
C1
28 (5S–FE)
I3
29 (5S–FE)
J27
A
31
C2
28 (5S–FE)
I4
29 (5S–FE)
J28
B
31
C7
30
I8
29 (5S–FE)
J29
31
31
C9
B
30
I9
29 (5S–FE)
J40
32
C10
C
30
I10
29 (5S–FE)
K1
29 (5S–FE)
D1
28 (5S–FE)
I11
29 (5S–FE)
M1
29 (5S–FE)
D5
30
I14
29 (5S–FE)
P1
29 (5S–FE)
D11
30
I16
30
P2
29 (5S–FE)
E5
28 (5S–FE)
J3
31
S6
31
A
30
J4
31
T2
29 (5S–FE)
E8
B
30
J7
A
31
T3
31
E9
C
30
J8
B
31
V1
29 (5S–FE)
E10
D
30
J10
31
V2
29 (5S–FE)
F4
A
28 (5S–FE)
J11
31
V4
29 (5S–FE)
F6
C
28 (5S–FE)
J12
31
V5
29 (5S–FE)
F14
32
J15
31
V7
29 (5S–FE)
H3
28 (5S–FE)
J19
31
E7
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
1
See Page
24
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1B
1C
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
22
Cowl Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
1J
1K
1R
1W
2A
2C
2F
2J
2K
2L
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
EB1
38 (5S–FE)
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
ID1
40
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
42
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
II2
II3
II4
IJ1
IK1
IK2
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
38 (5S–FE)
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
38 (5S–FE)
Intake Manifold
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
E3
38 (5S–FE)
I1
42
I2
42
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
I5
Engine Wire
A11
A13
3
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
I3
42
Cowl Wire
I6
A14
DARK GRAY
1
Code
C1
C2
DARK GRAY
DARK GRAY
1 2
1 2
C7
15
2
1 2
4
C9 (B)
C9 (B)
(TMC Made)
14 15
(TMMK Made)
C10 (C)
C10 (C)
(TMC Made) BROWN
BROWN
2 5 6
7 8
2 5 6
14 15
7 8
1 2
ENGINE CONTROL (5S–FE)
∗ 1 : w/ Engine Immobiliser System
∗ 2 : w/o Engine Immobiliser System
D5
D1
BLACK
X X 3
X
X 8 X
X
12 X X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
D11
E5
ORANGE
GREEN
1 2 3
1 2
16 X X X X X X X
X 7 X 5 4 X X X
E7 (A)
E7 (A)
E8 (B)
E8 (B)
(∗ 1)
(∗ 2)
(∗ 1) DARK GRAY
(∗ 2)
1 2 4 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 4 5 X 8 9 10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
12 13 14 19 20 21 22
12 13 14 15 16 21 22
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
E9 (C)
E9 (C)
E10 (D)
(∗ 1) DARK GRAY
(∗ 2)
DARK GRAY
F4 (A)
1 2 3 4 X 6 7 9 10 11 12 13
2 3 4 5 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3 4 X 6
14 15 X 17 X 19 22 23 24 25 26
14 15 X 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
7 8 9 X 11 12
1
F6 (C)
F14
1
4
H3
H8
DARK GRAY
DARK GRAY
5
1
2
1
2
3
4
3
4
H9
2
I1
I3
I4
I8
I9
I10
GRAY
GRAY
BLACK
BROWN
GRAY
BROWN
1 2 3
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
12
12
12
I11
I14
GRAY
BLACK
12
I16
J3
J4
BLACK
1 2
X
X
6
7
8
C C
C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
X X
DD DX
(Hint : See Page 7)
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
J10
GRAY
GRAY
BLACK
J11
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
D D D
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J12
J15
J19
J21
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
A A A
B B
B
B B
B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A A A
B B
A A A B B B B B
A A A
B B
A A A B B B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J23
J25
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
B
B B B
A A B B
B B C C
E E F F
E E F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J29
J40
B B B B
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
X
5
A
A
A
K1
M1
DARK GRAY
BLACK
1
A
1 2 3
(Hint : See Page 7)
P1
P2
S6
T2
GRAY
BLACK
BLUE
BLACK
6
1
1 2 3
1
2
T3
X X X X 6
X
V1
V2
V4
V5
V7
BLACK
BLACK
BLUE
BLACK
BLUE
1
2
3
1 2 3
1
2
1
2
1
2
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
15A
EFI
7
2K
5
B–W
C
(*1)
J35
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
5 2C
4 2F
W–B
W–B
II4
B–W
6
B–Y
(*1)
2 2J
B–W
2
B–Y
B–W
3
(*2)
EFI
RELAY
(*2)
C
8 A (* 1)
7 D (* 2)
MREL
B A
E 7 A , E 9 C , E10 D
B A
CODE
RXCK
4 C
8 D
J27 A , J28 B
2
3
(* 2)
L–Y
II4
(* 2)
2
L–Y
(*1)
L–Y
(* 2)
R–L
II4
(* 2)
4
R–L
(*1)
(* 2)
II4
(* 2)
1
G–W
(*1)
G–W
G–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4
TRANSPONDER
KEY COIL
1
T7
TRANSPONDER
KEY AMPLIFIER
5
EB
W–B
W–B
B–Y
W–B
B–Y
E B
TXCT
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE
10 C (* 1)
9 D (* 2)
5 C
3 D
R–L
E A
IE
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
E7
A
30
J27
E9
C
30
J28
E10
D
30
J35
See Page
A
31
B
31
Code
T7
See Page
31
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
2C
2F
2J
2K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
II4
See Page
42
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
IE
See Page
36(1MZ–FE)
38(5S–FE)
40
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Suport
Cowl Side Panel LH
E7 (A)
E9 (C)
(1MZ–FE)
(1MZ–FE)
E10 (D)
3 X
X X X 4 5 X
8 X X
X X X 10 X
X X
X X
X
J27 (A)
(5S–FE) DARK GRAY
7 8 9 X
X
B B
E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
J28 (B)
J35
T7
C C
1 2 3 4 5
E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
HEADLIGHT (w/o DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT)
2
4
1
40A
MAIN
15A
HEAD
(LH)
HEAD
RELAY
3
2
8 2K
3 2G
4 2G
6 2G
R
R–B
R–B
8 2C
R–W
1
3 2B
15A
HEAD
(RH)
3
3
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
H1
HEADLIGHT
LH
B
2
1
1
R–L
R–B
R–B
B
H2
HEADLIGHT
RH
2
R–L
B
B
3
F B
I17
INTEGRATION RELAY
D B
D B
J35 A , J36 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D A
F A
F A
4
R–L
1 A
F B
R–B
F4 A , F6 C
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
R–B
1 C
R–Y
R–B
R–L
8
7
17
LOW
HIGH
FLASH
16
W–B
C13
COMBINATION SW
8
9
W–B
HEAD
R–L
3 IG1
TAIL
C9
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
DIMMER SW
B–G
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
13
OFF
A
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
8
1J
BATTERY
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
7 1J
A
IG
W–B
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
W–B
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF
SERVICE HINTS
HEAD RELAY [ENGINE ROOM J/B NO.2]
2–1 : Closed with the light control SW at HEAD position or the dimmer SW at FLASH position
C13 COMBINATION SW
13–16 : Continuity with the light control SW at HEAD position
8–16 : Continuity with the dimmer SW at FLASH position
7–16 : Continuity with the dimmer SW at HIGH or FLASH position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C9
30
C13
30
F4
F6
H1
26 (1MZ–FE)
A
H2
28 (5S–FE)
C
Code
See Page
Code
26 (1MZ–FE)
See Page
J7
31
28 (5S–FE)
J11
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J32
31
28 (5S–FE)
J35
A
31
J36
B
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
I17
30
28 (5S–FE)
J5
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1J
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2B
2C
2G
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IG1
See Page
40
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
HEADLIGHT (w/o DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT)
C9
C9
(TMC Made)
8
(TMMK Made)
9
C13
8
F4 (A)
F6 (C)
1
9
H1
H2
BLACK
BLACK
1
1
1
2
X
X X X13 X 16 17
X X X 7
I17
3 4
J5
J7
ORANGE
GRAY
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
J11
2
3
A A A A A A
J32
GRAY
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J35 (A)
J36 (B)
D D F F
D D F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
B
B B B
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
3
8
MEMO
HEADLIGHT (w/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT)
G–R
R–B
2
4
1
R–L
HEAD
RELAY
40A
MAIN
3
2
8 2K
3 2G
4 2G
1
15A
HEAD LH
(UPR)
R–B
R
3 2B
15A
HEAD RH
(UPR)
G–R
R
2
6 1C
2
2
5 2G
2 2G
R
R
DIM
RELAY
1
3
2
R–W
2
2
2
2
1
2
R–L
3
1
D2
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RESISTOR
8 EB1
2
R–B
W–R
2
R–Y
3
2
1
DRL
NO. 4
RELAY
FL MAIN
3. 0W
1
H2
HEADLIGHT
RH
R–B
R–B
W–R
1 A
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
100A
ALT
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
1 C
B–G
4
2
2
2
R–Y
BATTERY
R
R
W–B
B–R
2 F
3
R–Y
B–R
B–R
1 F
2
H1
HEADLIGHT
LH
4 1B
E3
R–G
4
R–B
B
R
5A
DRL
NO. 2
W–B
5
1
1
2
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
3
EB
7
EB1
R
G–R
G–R
R–B
R–B
2
A
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
1
A
10A
H–LP LH
(LWR)
10A
H–LP RH
(LWR)
R–B
3
2
2
2
R
G–R
R–G
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
16
H–LP
H–ON
CSB
20
19
2
18
6
R
R–B
R
CSO
CSE
P–L
GR–R
4 IG1
9 IG1
8 IG1
P–L
5
V–Y
15
V–Y
B
B
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
4
CLTB
CLTS
R–Y
R
R
A40
AUTOMATIC LIGHT
CONTROL SENSOR
GR–R
B
H
DIM
R–Y
R–B
R–B
TAIL
3
CLTE
HEADLIGHT (w/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
R–L
7. 5A
DOME
R–B
D A
3
J27 A , J28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
I17
INTEGRATION
RELAY
2
12 2J
F B
R
R–L
1
R–B
4
R–B
R–Y
R–Y
G
G
1 1W
R–Y
R–W
R
7 1V
R–L
G–Y
R–Y
T
22
23
+B
IG
3
HI
PKB
BRK
13
14
4
E
12
R–W
Y
R–W
CHG–
21
IND
W–B
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
17
C
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 IG1
C
B
B
R–W
R–W
Y
B
1
1
R–W
W–B
6 EB1
Y
P3
PARKING
BRAKE SW
1
B2
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
WARNING SW
G2
GENERATOR
W–B
2
L
W–B
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
10A
GAUGE
1 1J
2 1D
R–L
R–L
R–B
R–Y
G
R–Y
R–L
R–W
3 IG1
G
R–Y
R–B
D
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
14
13
8
R–L
R–L
D
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
C 9 B , C10 C
COMBINATION
METER
DIMMER SW
9 B
OFF
TAIL
HEAD
LOW
HIGH
FLASH
W–B
R–W
7 B
C13
COMBINATION SW
8 B
HIGH
BEAM
BRAKE
7 C
7
3
IG2
16
R–Y
W–B
R–W
W–B
A
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 1J
8 1J
W–B
W–B
A
A
W–B
W–B
IF
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
IG
W–B
A
W–B
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
HEADLIGHT (w/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
The current from the FL MAIN is always flowing from the MAIN fuse to HEAD relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL H–LP of the
daytime running light relay (Main), from DOME fuse to TERMINAL +B of the daytime running light relay (Main) and from the
ALT fuse to Taillight relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL TAIL (TMMK Made) of the daytime running light relay (Main).
When the ignition SW is turned on, the current flowing through the GAUGE fuse flows to TERMINAL IG of the daytime
running light relay (Main).
1. DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT OPERATION
When the engine is started, voltage generated at TERMINAL L of the generator is applied to TERMINAL CHG– of the
daytime running light relay (Main). If the parking brake lever is pulled up (Parking brake SW on) at this time, the relay is not
activated so the daytime running light system does not operate. If the parking brake lever is then released (Parking brake
SW off), a signal is input to TERMINAL PKB of the relay.
This activates the daytime running light relay (Main) and the HEAD relay is turned to on, so the current flows from the MAIN
fuse to the HEAD relay (Point side) to TERMINAL 1 of the DIM relay to TERMINAL 4 to H–LP LH (LWR), H–LP RH (LWR)
fuses to TERMINAL 1 of the headlights to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL 1 of the daytime running light resistor to TERMINAL 2
to GROUND, causing the headlights to light up (Headlights light up dimmer than normal brightness.). Once the daytime
running light system operates and the headlights light up, the headlights remain on even if the parking brake lever is pulled
up (Parking brake SW on).
If the engine stalls and the ignition SW remains on, the headlights remain light up even through current is no longer output
from TERMINAL L of the generator. If the ignition SW is then turned off, the headlights go off.
If the engine is started with the parking brake lever released (Parking brake SW off), the daytime running light system
operates and headlights light up when the engine starts.
2. HEADLIGHT OPERATION
When the light control SW is switched to HEAD position and the dimmer SW is set to LOW position, causing the daytime
running light relay (Main) and the HEAD relay to turn on, so the current flows from the MAIN fuse to HEAD relay (Point side)
to DRL NO.2 fuse to TERMINAL 3 of the DRL NO.4 relay to TERMINAL 4 to TERMINAL H–ON of the daytime running light
relay (Main) to TERMINAL H to TERMINAL 3 of the integration relay to TERMINAL 4 to TERMINAL 13 of the light control
SW to TERMINAL 16 to GROUND, activating the DRL. NO.4 relay. The current to HEAD relay (Point side) then flows to
TERMINAL 1 of the DIM relay to TERMINAL 4 to H–LP LH (LWR), H–LP RH (LWR) fuses to TERMINAL 1 of the headlights
to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL 1 of the DRL NO.4 relay to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND, causing the headlights to light up at
normal intensity.
When the light control SW is switched to HEAD position and the dimmer SW is set to HIGH position, the signal from the
dimmer SW is input to the daytime running light relay (Main). This activates the daytime running light relay (Main) and the
HEAD relay is turned on, so the current flows from the MAIN fuse to HEAD relay (Point side) to TERMINAL 1 of the DIM
relay to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL DIM of the daytime running light relay (Main), activating the DIM relay. This causes
current to flow from TERMINAL 1 of the DIM relay to TERMINAL 2 to HEAD LH (UPR), HEAD RH (UPR) fuses to TERMINAL
2 of the headlights to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL 1 of the DRL NO.4 relay to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND, causing the
headlights to light up at high beam and the high beam indicator light to light up.
When the dimmer SW is switched to FLASH position, the signal from the dimmer SW is input to the daytime running light
relay (Main). This activates the daytime running light relay (Main) and the HEAD relay is turned on, so the current flows from
the MAIN fuse to HEAD relay (Point side) to DRL NO.2 fuse to TERMINAL 3 of the DRL NO.4 relay to TERMINAL 4 to
TERMINAL H–ON of the daytime running light relay (Main) to TERMINAL H to TERMINAL 8 of the dimmer SW to
TERMINAL 16 to GROUND, activating the DRL NO.4 relay. At the same time, the current flows from the TERMINAL 1 of the
DIM relay to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL DIM of the daytime running light relay (Main), activating the DIM relay, and also
flows from the HEAD LH (UPR), HEAD RH (UPR) fuses to TERMINAL 2 of the headlights to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL 1 of
the DRL NO.4 relay to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND, causing the headlights to light up at high beam and the high beam
indicator light to light up.
3. AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL OPERATION
When the daytime running light is operating and the Automatic control sensor detects a decrease in the ambient light (It
continues less than approx. 2500 lux over about 20 seconds, and it is less than 1000 lux.), the automatic light control
operation starts. At the same time, daytime running light relay (Main) is activated, so current flows from the ALT fuse to the
Taillight relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL TAIL of the daytime running light relay (Main), and the DRL NO.2 fuse to the DRL
NO.4 relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL H–ON of the daytime running light relay (Main), activating both the Taillight relay and the
DRL NO.4 relay, so that the taillights and headlights light up.
When the automatic light control sensor detects an increase in the ambient light (It continues more than approx. 1000 lux
over about 20 seconds, and it is more than approx. 2500 lux), the ignition SW is turned to off, the light control SW is turned to
HEAD position, and the automatic light control operation stops.
SERVICE HINTS
HEAD RELAY [ENGINE ROOM J/B NO.2]
1–2 : Closed with the light control SW at HEAD position or the dimmer SW at FLASH position
Closed with the engine running and the parking brake lever is released (Parking brake SW off)
TAILLIGHT RELAY [INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B]
5–3 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
D6 DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
5, 7,17–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the light control SW at HEAD position or the dimmer SW at FLASH position
Approx. 12 volts with the engine running and the parking brake lever is released
(Parking brake SW off)
6,15–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
8–GROUND : Continuity with the parking brake lever pulled up
11–GROUND : 13.9–15.1 volts with the engine running at 2000 rpm 25°C (77°F)
12–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the high beam light up
13–GROUND : Always continuity
16–GROUND : Continuity with the dimmer SW at HIGH or FLASH position
18–GROUND : Continuity with the brake fluid level not enough
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
A40
30
26 (1MZ–FE)
B2
28 (5S–FE)
C9
B
30
C10
C
30
C13
30
26 (1MZ–FE)
D2
28 (5S–FE)
D6
F4
30
A
26 (1MZ–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
Code
F6
See Page
C
F9
F
G2
H1
H2
I17
Code
See Page
26 (1MZ–FE)
J1
31
28 (5S–FE)
J2
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J4
31
28 (5S–FE)
J5
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J7
31
28 (5S–FE)
J11
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J27
A
31
28 (5S–FE)
J28
B
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
30
P3
31
HEADLIGHT (w/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT)
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
2
See Page
24
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.2 (Near the Battery)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
1C
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1V
1W
2B
2G
2J
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
EB1
IG1
IG2
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
40
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
No 2)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
E3
See Page
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
A40
B2
BLACK
GRAY
1
1 X 3 4
C9 (B)
(TMC Made)
7 8
2
9
C9 (B)
C10 (C)
(TMMK Made)
7 8
(TMC Made) BROWN
9
C10 (C)
7
D2
C13
(TMMK Made) BROWN
GRAY
7
X X X 7
8
1
X X X X 1314 X 16
D6
F4 (A)
2
G2
F6 (C)
BLACK
1
X 2 3 4 5 6
1
1
X X X X X
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 X X
H1
H2
BLACK
BLACK
1
2
I17
J2
J1
BLACK
1
3
2
3
1 2 3 4
A A A
B B
B
B
C C
B B B B C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J4
J5
J7
BLACK
ORANGE
GRAY
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
A A A A A A
X X
DD DX
(Hint : See Page 7)
J11
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
HEADLIGHT (w/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT)
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
D D
F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
P3
1
MEMO
LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
B
3 2B
1
5
7. 5A
DOME
10A
GAUGE
1
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
40A
MAIN
2
12 2J
3
2
6 1C
*
*
*
*
G–R
3
2
8 2K
R
G–R
T
H
(* 2 *4)
D6 A ,
(*1)
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
(* 2)
B
B–R
G–Y
E3
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
G–R
(EXCEPT * 2 * 4)
5 A (* 3)
2 B (* 4)
17 B
B
R
H–LP
B
TAIL
B
(* 1)
B–R
6 A (* 3)
19 B (* 4)
16 B
R–B
(*2)
(* 2 * 4)
B–R
1
HEAD
RELAY
A
A
B
4
R–B
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
2 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
3 : TMC MADE
4 : TMMK MADE
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
4 1B
R–B
1 1W
(*2)
1 C
1 F
2 F
2 C
7
3 C
100A
ALT
1 A
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
1 C
10
4 C
G
W–B
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0L
I17 C
INTEGRATION RELAY
7 1S
C13
COMBINATION SW
14
13
OFF
TAIL
R–G
8 1J
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
7 1J
6
R–Y
B–G
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
HEAD
W–B
16
BATTERY
1
A
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
With the ignition SW turned on, the current flows to TERMINAL 7 of the integration relay through GAUGE fuse.
Voltage is applied at all times to TERMINAL (C) 2 of the integration relay through the taillight relay coil side, and to
TERMINAL (C) 3 through the HEAD relay coil side (w/o daytime running light) or through the daytime running light relay
(Main) (w/ daytime running light).
1. NORMAL LIGHTING OPERATION
With the light control SW turned to TAIL position, a signal is input into TERMINAL (C) 1 of the integration relay. Due to this
signal, the current flowing to TERMINAL (C) 2 of the relay flows to TERMINAL (C) 1 to TERMINAL 14 of the light control SW
to TERMINAL 16 to GROUND, and taillight relay causes taillights to turn on.
With the light control SW turned to HEAD position, a signal is input into TERMINALS (C) 1 and (C) 4 of the integration relay.
Due to this signal, the current flowing to TERMINAL (C) 3 of the relay flows to TERMINAL (C) 4 to TERMINAL 13 of the light
control SW to TERMINAL 16 to GROUND in the headlight circuit, and causes taillight and HEAD relay to turn the lights on.
The taillight circuit is same as above.
2. LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF OPERATION
With light on and ignition SW turned off (Input signal goes to TERMINAL 7 of the relay), when the driver’s door is opened
(Input signal goes to TERMINAL 6 of the relay), the relay operates and the current is cut off which flows from TERMINAL (C)
2 of the relay to TERMINAL (C) 1 In taillight circuit and from TERMINAL (C) 3 to TERMINAL (C) 4 in headlight circuit.
As a result, all lights are turned off automatically.
SERVICE HINTS
HEAD RELAY [ENGINE ROOM J/B NO.2]
2–1 : Closed with the light control SW at HEAD position or the dimmer SW at FLASH position
Closed with the engine running and the parking brake lever released (w/ daytime running light)
TAILLIGHT RELAY [INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B]
3–5 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
D12 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH
1–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door open
I17 (C) INTEGRATION RELAY
7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
6–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door open
1–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
10–GROUND : Always continuity
(C) 2–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(C) 3–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(C) 4–GROUND : Continuity with the light control SW at HEAD position
(C) 1–GROUND : Continuity with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C13
D6
30
A
30
B
30
D12
F4
32
A
26 (1MZ–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
Code
F6
See Page
C
F9
F
I17
C
J1
26 (1MZ–FE)
Code
See Page
J2
31
28 (5S–FE)
J7
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J11
31
28 (5S–FE)
J32
31
30
31
LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1B
1C
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2B
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
2J
2K
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
IG
Ground Points Location
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
E3
Wire Harness with Splice Points
36 (1MZ–FE)
Code
Cowl Wire
E3
C13
See Page
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
D6 (A)
D6 (B)
(TMC Made) GRAY
X X X
X
X X
X X
(TMMK Made)
5 6
X
X 2
16 17 19 X X
X X X X 1314 X 16
D12
X X X X X
F4 (A)
F6 (C)
F9 (F)
I17 (C)
ORANGE
1
1
1
1
J1
B
B B B B
J2
J7
BLACK
GRAY
A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
2
B
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J32
J11
A
A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
GRAY
1 2 3 4
MEMO
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
2 1L
3 2K
W
H7
HAZARD SW
10A
HAZARD
G–R
7. 5A
TURN
10
8
C13
TURN SIGNAL SW
[COMB. SW]
OFF
RH
HAZARD
TURN
G–W
6
2
1
3
G–Y
1
5
G–B
G–R
9
G–B
7
T6
TURN SIGNAL
FLASHER
2
G–Y
LH
G–B
ON
C
D
G–B
3
G–Y
D
G–B
C
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–B
W–B
G–Y
D
G–B
C
8 1V
1 EB1
6 1S
2 1A
8 1H
6 1H
G–B
G–Y
1 B
1 C
LH
RH
16 B
W–B
C 9 B , C10 C
TURN SIGNAL INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
2
F2
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT RH
3
W–B
5
R11
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
5
6
W–B
6
W–B
2
R9
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
3
W–B
IG
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E4
EB
W–B
A
W–B
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B11
BP
W–B
F1
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT LH
G–Y
B B
J35 A , J36 B
G–Y
G–B
G–B
B A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–Y
11 1S
5 1A 10 1C
IF
SERVICE HINTS
T6 TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW on or the hazard SW on
1–GROUND : Changes from 12 to 0 volts with the ignition SW on and the turn signal SW LEFT or RIGHT position,
and with the hazard SW on
3–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
B
30
F2
28 (5S–FE)
C10
C
30
H7
30
R9
33
30
J5
31
R11
33
26 (1MZ–FE)
J11
31
T6
31
28 (5S–FE)
J15
31
C13
F1
F2
26 (1MZ–FE)
J35
A
J36
See Page
C9
B
31
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1A
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1H
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1L
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2K
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1C
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
EB1
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
No 2)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
BP
44
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E4
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
Code
B11
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING LIGHT
C9 (B)
C9 (B)
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
1
16
1
C10 (C)
C10 (C)
(TMC Made) BROWN
1
16
C13
(TMMK Made) BROWN
1
F1
F2
H7
J5
GRAY
GRAY
BLACK
ORANGE
2
2
3
3
X
X
5 6 7 8 9 10
J35 (A)
2
X X X
X
X X X X
3
J11
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J15
1
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J36 (B)
R9
R11
B B
B B
X 5 6
X 5 6
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
BLACK
CCCD D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
T6
1
2
3
A
MEMO
STOP LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
15A
STOP
10A
GAUGE
1 1S
2 1D
W
R–L
7 1C
D
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
R–L
S6
STOP LIGHT
SW
R–L
D
7 C
1
C 8 A , C10 C
G–W
REAR LIGHTS
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
Y–G
3 A
4 1R
5
IF2
G–W
Y–G
2 1S
L3
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
7
4
8
DELAY
HOLD
2
11
G–R
1
5
B11
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BL
W–B
W–B
A
BP
W–B
G–R
2
W–B
5
R11
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–R
2
W–B
W–B
1
H10
HIGH MOUNTED
STOP LIGHT
2
R9
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
R
B7
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current is applied at all times through the STOP fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the stop light SW.
When the ignition SW is turned on, current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor, and also
flows through the rear lights warning light to TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor.
STOP LIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
When the ignition SW is turned on and the brake pedal is pressed (Stop light SW on), if the stop light circuit is open, the
current flowing from TERMINAL 7 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 2 and 1 changes, so the light failure sensor
detects the disconnection and the warning circuit of the light failure sensor is activated.
As a result, the current flows from TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 11 to GROUND and turns the rear
lights warning light on. By pressing the brake pedal, the current flowing to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor keeps the
warning circuit on holding and the warning light on until the ignition SW is turned off.
SERVICE HINTS
S6 STOP LIGHT SW
2–1 : Closed with the brake pedal depressed
L3 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
1, 2, 7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the stop light SW on
4, 8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
11–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
C8
C10
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A
30
J4
31
R9
33
C
30
J40
32
R11
33
32
L3
32
S6
31
H10
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1R
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IF2
See Page
40
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BP
44
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
B7
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
Code
B11
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
STOP LIGHT
C8 (A)
C8 (A)
(TMC Made) BLUE
(TMMK Made) BLUE
3
3
C10 (C)
C10 (C)
(TMC Made) BROWN
H10
(TMMK Made) BROWN
1
7
J4
J40
2
7
L3
R9
R11
2
2
X 5
X 5
BLACK
X X
DD DX
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
S6
BLUE
1
2
1 2
4 X
X 7 8 X 11 X
MEMO
INTERIOR LIGHT
B
W–B
1 2A
1
SHORT
PIN
2
7. 5A
DOME
12 2J
R
R
R
B1
R
1
2
R
B5
R
B
R
1
C16
CONDENSER
L3
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
R
R
2
DOOR
I19
INTERIOR LIGHT
1
L5
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT
2
OFF
ON
R
1 A
2
2
P5
PERSONAL LIGHT
V8
VANITY LIGHT LH
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
F4 A , F6 C
1
V9
VANITY LIGHT RH
1
1 C
(*1)
R
B1
1
2
R–W
1
(* 1)
W–B
W–B
W–B
B–G
W–B
(W/ FADE OUT)
R–W
(W/O FADE OUT)
R–Y
B 3 : *1
B 2 : *2
BATTERY
W–B
3 1F
3 1V
W–B
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
BM
IE
L6
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
1
* 1 : W/ MOON ROOF
* 2 : W/O MOON ROOF
W–B
* 3 : W/O THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
* 4 : W/ THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
7 1J
I18 A , B
INTEGRATION RELAY
4
D10
DIODE
(DOME)
6 1F 12 1S
E
R
R–G
D7
DIODE
(COURTESY)
R
R–W
1
2
R–G
2
J33 A , J34 B
10
1
R–W
11
I15
IGNITION KEY
CYLINDER LIGHT
C9
OPEN DOOR
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
J33 A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
R–W
E A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
7 1S
D
A
D
A
D
A
2
R
4 1G
R–G
1
11 1H
R–W
G–R
R
R
2 1F
R–W
1 1M
R–W
2 1M
8 A (*3)
6 B (*4)
6
(W/O FADE OUT)
8 1G
R–W
9 1S
(W/ FADE OUT)
5 1F
R
1 1W
R–Y
2
R
1
R–W
10
E A
D B
R–G
R–W
(W/ FADE OUT)
R–W
(W/O FADE OUT)
R–G
1
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
1
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
6 IN2
R–W
1
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
R–W
8 IN2
1
INTERIOR LIGHT
SERVICE HINTS
I18 (A), (B) INTEGRATION RELAY
1–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
4–GROUND : Continuity with the one of each door (Front LH, RH, rear LH and RH) open
6–GROUND : Continuity with the front LH door open
10–GROUND : Always continuity
D12, D13, D14, D15 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH, RH, REAR LH, RH
1–GROUND : Closed with the door open
L6 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SW
1–GROUND : Closed with the luggage compartment door open
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C9
30
C16
32
D7
30
D10
30
D12
32
D13
32
D14
32
D15
F4
A
Code
See Page
F4
A
F6
C
Code
See Page
28 (5S–FE)
J33
A
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J34
B
31
28 (5S–FE)
L3
32
30
L5
32
A
30
L6
32
B
30
P5
33
I19
32
V8
33
32
J11
31
V9
33
26 (1MZ–FE)
J16
31
I15
I18
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1F
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Roof Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2A
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2J
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1G
1H
1J
1M
1S
1V
1W
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IN2
See Page
42
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
BM
44
Roof Left
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
B1
B2
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Roof Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
B3
44
Roof Wire
B5
44
Floor Wire
C9
C9
(TMC Made)
10 11
D7
D10
BLACK
BLACK
1 2
1 2
C16
(TMMK Made)
1 2
10 11
D12
D13
D14
D15
1
1
1
1
F4 (A)
1
F6 (C)
I15
I18 (A)
I18 (B)
(w/o Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
1
8
1 2
I19
(w/ Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
X X 6
X X
X X X X X X X
J11
A
A
J16
J33 (A)
J34 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
E E E
D D D E E E
D D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
L3
1
X
X X X
1
2
L6
GRAY
1
2
P5
V9
(TMMK Made)
1
2
V8
V8
(TMC Made) BLUE
(TMMK Made)
1
1
1 2
V9
(TMC Made) BLUE
L5
GRAY
2
1
2
1
2
ILLUMINATION
G
1
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
7. 5A
PANEL
2
4 1B
3
6 1C
4 1J
5 1D
G
G
B–R
G–R
G
A
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E3
J13 A , J14 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B A
A
B A
G–R
B
G
A24
ASHTRAY ILLUMINATION
2
1
2
B
G
(* 3)
12
(* 3)
A34
A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
G
(* 4)
(* 4)
7
B
B
3
6
G
(* 4)
1
FL MAIN
3. 0W
G
1
B5
BLOWER SW
2
4
B B
(* 4)
B–G
2
B
I17
INTEGRATION
RELAY
1 A
6
B B
(* 4)
(* 5)
2
B B
A14
A/C SW
G–Y
C5
CIGARETTE LIGHTER ILLUMINATION
G
B
G
B B
(* 4)
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
17
B B
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
100A ALT
(*6)
G–R
2 F
F4 A , F9 F
B–R
1 F
16
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
B–R
(* 5)
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
14
OFF
A B
A B
A B
A B
A A
A A
TAIL
HEAD
A A
16
J13 A , J14 B
W–B
A
W–B
B
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
8 1J
6 1V
7 1J
4 1H
W–B
BATTERY
C13
COMBINATION SW
A
IG
B
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
G
G
G
G
A A
A A
A A
A A
J30 A , J31 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
12
G
G3
GLOVE BOX LIGHT AND SW
3
13
C10
COMBINATION METER ILLUMINATION
[COMB. METER]
O2
A/T SHIFT LEVER ILLUMINATION
[O/D MAIN SW]
1
2
W–B
B
B
(* 2)
B
W–G
R4 C
9 C
RADIO AND PLAYER
2 C
W–G
5 B
(* 1)
G
R2 B , R3 A
3
RADIO AND PLAYER
H7
HAZARD SW
10 A
2
1
(*1)
(* 2)
10 IH1
G
G
G
G
A B
(*1)
A B
G
G
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
(* 1)
W–G
5 IH2
A
E
B
B
G
W–B
A
D
A
3
1
E
B
T
W–B
D
A
ILL
E
B
B
D
A
2
B
J16 A , J17 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
* 1 : SEPARATE TYPE AMPLIFIER
* 2 : BUILT–IN TYPE AMPLIFIER
* 3 : AUTOMATIC A/C
* 4 : MANUAL A/C
* 5 : TMMK MADE W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 6 : EXCEPT * 5
IF
R7
RHEOSTAT
ILLUMINATION
SERVICE HINTS
TAILLIGHT RELAY [INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B]
5–3 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
C13 COMBINATION SW
14–16 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
A14
30
A24
30
A34
30
Code
F9
See Page
F
Code
See Page
28 (5S–FE)
J17
B
31
G3
30
J30
A
31
H7
30
J31
B
31
B5
30
I7
30
C5
30
J2
31
R2
B
31
C10
30
J5
31
R3
A
31
C13
30
J7
31
R4
C
31
D6
30
J11
31
R5
31
R7
31
F4
A
F9
F
26 (1MZ–FE)
J13
A
31
28 (5S–FE)
J14
B
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J16
A
31
O2
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1B
1C
1D
1H
1J
1V
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IH1
IH2
See Page
40
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel No.2
No 2 Wire (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
E3
See Page
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
A14
A24
B5
A34
C5
BLACK
3 4
1 2
2 X 12
X X X X
C10
C10
(TMC Made) BROWN
(TMMK Made) BROWN
12 13
D6
1
X
6 7
C13
12 13
F4 (A)
X
X X X 14 X 16
F9 (F)
G3
ORANGE
BLACK
X X X
1
X
X X X X X
1
1
2
2
16 17 X X
H7
I17
BLACK
X 2
J2
J5
BLACK
ORANGE
A A A
3 X
1 2
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J11
J7
GRAY
A
A A A A A A
A
J13 (A)
J14 (B)
BLUE
BLUE
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
B B B B B B
B B B B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
2
J16 (A)
J17 (B)
J30 (A)
J31 (B)
O2
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
BLUE
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
D D D
E E E
1
3
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
ILLUMINATION
R2 (B)
X 5
R3 (A)
R4 (C)
X 10
2
9
X
X
R5
R7
BLACK
BLACK
2
6
1 2 3
MEMO
TAILLIGHT
1
5
10A
TAIL
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
2
9 1C
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
HEAD
C13
COMBINATION SW
FL MAIN
3. 0W
W–B
16
1
2
F2
FRONT PARKING LIGHT RH
TAIL
G
B8
1
G
G
14
OFF
B8
G
(* 3)
G–O
G–O
C B
L2
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT RH
W–B
I17
INTEGRATION RELAY
1
2
1
2
2
1
A
W–B
A
W–B
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
B–G
1 A
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
C B
F1
FRONT PARKING LIGHT LH
100A
ALT
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
2 F
F4 A , F9 F
B–R
1 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
B–R
2
G
J35 A , J36 B
A A
(* 1)
G
17
G–Y
L1
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT LH
W–B
(* 2)
16
G
B5
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
B–R
(* 1)
G–R
A
G–R
G–O
A
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
A
A
E3
8 1S
G–O
6 1C
G–R
4 1B
3
8 1J
W–B
BATTERY
W–B
7 1J
E4
B9
W–B
A
W–B
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
EB
W–B
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
10A
GAUGE
* 1 : TMMK MADE W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 2 : EXCEPT *1
* 3 : TMC MADE
2
1D
R–L
D
1 1S
R–L
D
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 C
C 8 A , C10 C
R–L
G
REAR LIGHTS
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
G
Y–G
3 A
IF2
Y–G
5
8
4
L3
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
3
DELAY
G
(* 3)
11
G–O
9
G–O
(* 3)
TAIL
TAIL
3
5
B11
W–B
W–B
5
1
SIDE
MARKER
3
SIDE
MARKER
R9
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
G
W–B
3
1
W–B
B11
W–B
B9
4
(*3)
W–B
W–B
R10
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
3
W–B
R8
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
4
W–B
G–O
G
B8
R11
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
G
G–O
B7
(* 3)
B10
G–O
G–O
A
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
BP
BL
TAILLIGHT
SYSTEM OUTLINE
When the light control SW is turned to TAIL or HEAD position. The current flows to TERMINAL 3 of the light failure sensor
through the TAIL fuse.
When the ignition SW is turned on, the current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 8 of the light failure sensor, and
also flows through the rear lights warning light to TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor.
TAILLIGHT DISCONNECTION WARNING
With the ignition SW on and the light control SW turned to TAIL or HEAD position, if the taillight circuit is open, the light failure
sensor detects the failure by the change in current flowing from TERMINAL 3 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 9, and
the warning circuit of the light failure sensor is activated.
As a result, the current flows from TERMINAL 4 of the light failure sensor to TERMINAL 11 to GROUND and turns the rear
lights warning light on, which remains on until the light control SW is turned off
SERVICE HINTS
TAILLIGHT RELAY [INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B]
5–3 : Closed with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
L3 LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
4, 8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
3–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
11–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C8
A
30
C10
C
30
Code
F9
See Page
F
Code
See Page
26 (1MZ–FE)
J40
32
28 (5S–FE)
L1
32
C13
30
I17
30
L2
32
D6
30
J2
31
L3
32
26 (1MZ–FE)
J4
31
R8
33
28 (5S–FE)
J7
31
L9
33
26 (1MZ–FE)
J11
31
R10
33
28 (5S–FE)
J12
31
R11
33
F1
F2
F4
A
26 (1MZ–FE)
J35
A
31
28 (5S–FE)
J36
B
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1B
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1C
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IF2
See Page
40
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BP
44
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
36 (1MZ–FE)
E3
36 (1MZ–FE)
B5
44
B9
44
B11
C8 (A)
C8 (A)
(TMC Made) BLUE
(TMMK Made) BLUE
3
C10 (C)
C10 (C)
(TMC Made) BROWN
(TMMK Made) BROWN
7
Floor Wire
B10
Floor Wire
3
Wire Harness with Splice Points
B8
Engine Room Main Wire
38 (5S–FE)
See Page
B7
Cowl Wire
38 (5S–FE)
E4
Code
C13
7
X X X
X X X X 14 X 16
D6
F1
F2
GRAY
GRAY
F4 (A)
F9 (F)
ORANGE
1
X
X X X X X
16 17 X X
I17
J2
1 2
1 2
1 2
J4
1
J11
J7
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
A A A
X X
DD DX
A
A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J12
J35 (A)
J36 (B)
J40
L1
BLACK
A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
GRAY
A
A A
C C
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
1
2
2
TAILLIGHT
L2
L3
R8
R9
R10
R11
X
3 4
1 3
X
3 4
1 3
GRAY
1
2
3
4 X
X 8 9 X 11 X
X 5
X 5
MEMO
BACK–UP LIGHT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
10A
GAUGE
R–L
1 1J
J28
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
II2
3
C
J27
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
C
R–B
F
R–L
F
II3
R–L
A
(5S–FE)
(1MZ–FE)
R–L
5 1V
13 1S
A
R–B
B8
R–B
R10
BACK–UP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
8 A (A/T)
1 B (M/T)
1
3
W–B
2 A (A/T)
2 B (M/T)
W–B
B9
W–B
R8
BACK–UP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
BACK–UP LIGHT SW(M/T)
P1 A
BACK–UP LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SW](A/T)
B1 B
R–B
R–L
(5S–FE)
A
(1MZ–FE)
R–L
A
R–B
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BL
1
3
SERVICE HINTS
P1 (A) BACK–UP LIGHT SW [PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW] (A/T)
(A) 2–(A) 8 : Closed with the shift lever at R position
B1 (B) BACK–UP LIGHT SW (M/T)
(B) 2–(B) 1 : Closed with the shift lever at R position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
B1
See Page
B
Code
See Page
26 (1MZ–FE)
J27
31
Code
P1
See Page
A
29 (5S–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
J28
31
R8
33
J21
31
J40
32
R10
33
J24
31
P1
A
27 (1MZ–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire And Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
II2
42
II3
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
BL
44
Ground Points Location
Under the Left Center Pillar
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
B8
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
J21
GRAY
GRAY
2
See Page
B9
B1 (B)
1
Code
Floor Wire
44
J24
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor Wire
J27
A A A
A A A
A
A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
J28
J40
P1 (A)
R8
R10
1 X
3
1 X
3
GRAY
A
A
A
A
A
A
F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
X
2
8
WIPER AND WASHER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
* 1 : W/ INT TIME ADJUST
* 2 : W/O INT TIME ADJUST
25A
WIPER
E
B
E
A
L
J35 A , J36 B
L
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
1A
4 1C
2
M
W2
WASHER
MOTOR
1
EW
L–W
WF
WIPER SW
WASHER SW OFF
6
11
EW
2
L–W
L
HI
LO
INT
WF
IK1
+1
+1
7
L–B
+2
(*2)
L–Y
+2
8
L–O
+B
17
L
+S
16
+B
(*1)
INT1
INT2
B1
OFF
ON
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
+S
A
A
L
W–B
3
5
2
1
+2
+1
B
S
M
E
4
W–B
F3
FRONT WIPER
MOTOR
10 2J
A
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4 2F
W–B
C11
WIPER AND WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
A
EB
SYSTEM OUTLINE
With the ignition SW turned on, the current flows to TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW, TERMINAL 2 of the washer
motor and TERMINAL 2 of the front wiper motor through the WIPER fuse.
1. LOW SPEED POSITION
With the wiper and washer SW turned to LO position, the current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to
TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 5 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 4 to GROUND and causes the front wiper motor to run
at low speed.
2. HIGH SPEED POSITION
With the wiper and washer SW turned to HI position, the current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to
TERMINAL 8 to TERMINAL 3 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 4 to GROUND and causes the front wiper motor to run
at high speed.
3. INT POSITION
With the wiper and washer SW turned to INT position, the wiper relay operates and current flows from TERMINAL 17 of the
wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND. This activates the intermittent circuit and the current flows from
TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 5 of the front wiper motor to TERMINAL 4 to
GROUND and the wiper operates. Intermittent operation is controlled by a condenser charge and discharge function in the
relay.
4. WASHER CONTINUOUS OPERATION
With the wiper and washer SW pulled to WASHER position (Washer SW ON position), the current flows from the WIPER
fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the washer motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 11 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 2 to
GROUND and causes the washer motor to run and the window washer to spray. Simultaneously, current flows from the
WIPER fuse to TERMINAL 17 of the wiper and washer SW to TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL 5 of the front wiper motor to
TERMINAL 4 to GROUND, causing the wiper to function.
SERVICE HINTS
C11 WIPER AND WASHER SW [COMB. SW]
2–GROUND : Always continuity
17–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW on and the wiper and washer SW at LO position
Approx. 12 volts every approx. 1 to 10 seconds intermittently with the ignition SW on
and the wiper and washer SW at INT position
16–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW on and unless the front wiper motor at STOP position
8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW on and the wiper and washer SW at HI position
F3 FRONT WIPER MOTOR
1–2 : Closed unless the front wiper motor at STOP position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C11
Code
30
26 (1MZ–FE)
F3
28 (5S–FE)
See Page
J11
31
J15
J35
31
A
31
Code
J36
See Page
B
W2
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1A
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2F
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2J
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1C
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IK1
See Page
42
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
31
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
WIPER AND WASHER
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
IG
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
40
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
Instrument Panel Brace LH
C11
F3
BLACK
GRAY
J11
A
1 2 3
X 2 X X X X 7 8 X
A
A
A
J36 (B)
E E
E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
A A A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
W2
BLACK
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
4 5
X 11 X X X X 16 17 X
J35 (A)
J15
BLACK
1 2 X
MEMO
POWER WINDOW
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
2
P9
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
10
11
BW
10
IE2
BW
FRONT LH
5
DOWN
L
1
L
L
B
(* 4)
B13
L(* 3)
(* 4)
30A
POWER
B
L
10A
GAUGE
L(* 4)
B
(* 3)
25A
DOOR
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
L(* 3)
POWER
RELAY
5 1G
7 1J
3 1S
13 1G
W–B
L
L
C B
W–B(*3)
10
W–B(*4)
(* 1)12 A
(*2) 3 B
7
W–B(*3)
13 A (*1)
1 B (*2)
DU
DD
1
5
R
E
4
G
E
3
W–B(*4)
A A
L–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J33 A , J34 B
L–W
1 1D
3
R–B
12 1G
2
6
I18 A ,
B
8 A (* 1)
6 B (* 2)
R–G
INTEGRATION RELAY
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 1S
(* 4)
W–B
B13
L
A
A
A
L
W–B
W–B
D B
(* 4)
R–G
R
G
W–B
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
R–G
6 IN2
D12
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
IE1
W–B
1
20
7 1G
1
3 1V
A
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
R–G
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
(* 3)
E A
IE
1
M
2
P10
POWER WINDOW
MOTOR FRONT LH
* 1 : W/O THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
* 2 : W/ THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
* 3 : TMC MADE
* 4 : TMMK MADE
P9
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
FRONT RH
REAR LH
REAR RH
WINDOW LOCK SW
LOCK
NORMAL
R–Y
9 IE2
R–Y
L
RRD
13
6
IE2
12
IE2
R–B
G–Y
R–L
7 IE2
G–Y
G–W
5 IE2
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
RRU
8
R–L
G–W
11 IE2
RLD
12
R–B
RLU
9
G–B
PD
6
G–B
PU
14
5 IN2
7 IN2
L
A
5
R–B
L
L
2 BP1
3 BP1
1 BP1
3 BO1
1 BO1
2
M
1
P11
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
FRONT RH
5
2
M
1
P12
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR LH
3
B
UP
4
SD
U
D
1
5
2
M
1
P13
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR RH
DOWN
R–B
G–B
D
2
SU
R
U
1
DOWN
UP
3
B
G
R
G
1
R–B
G–B
D
4
SD
R
U
3
2
SU
G
4
B
P6
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW FRONT RH
2
SD
UP
5
SU
DOWN
R–L
G–W
L
2 BO1
P7
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR LH
6 IM2
L
5 IM2
L
L
4 IM2
9 IN2
G–B
R–Y
IF1
P8
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR RH
IF1
G–Y
L
R–L
G–W
1
POWER WINDOW
SYSTEM OUTLINE
With the ignition SW turned on, current flows through the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 7 of the integration relay to TERMINAL
(A) 12 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 3 (w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 1 of the power relay to TERMINAL 2 to
GROUND, this activates the relay and the current flowing to TERMINAL 5 of the relay from the POWER fuse flows to
TERMINAL 3 of the relay to TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW.
1. MANUAL OPERATION (DRIVER’S WINDOW)
With the ignition SW turned on and with the power window master SW (Driver’s) in UP position, the current flowing from
TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW flows to TERMINAL 1 of the master SW to TERMINAL 1 of the
power window motor to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 5 of the master SW to TERMINALS 3 and 4 to GROUND and causes
the power window motor to rotate in the up direction. The window ascends only while the SW is being pushed.
In down operation, the flow of current from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW to TERMINAL 5 of the
master SW causes the flow of current from TERMINAL 2 of the power window motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 1 of the
master SW to TERMINALS 3 and 4 to GROUND, flowing in the opposite detection to manual up operation and causing the
motor to rotate in reverse, lowering the window.
2. AUTO DOWN OPERATION (DRIVER’S WINDOW)
When the driver’s window SW is pushed strongly to the down side, the current flowing to TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the
power window master SW flows to the down contact point and auto down contact point of the driver’s SW.
This activates the relay (Down side) inside the power window master SW and the hold circuit also turns on at the same time,
so the relay (Down side) remains activated even when the SW is released.
Current flows at this time from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW to TERMINAL 5 to TERMINAL 2 of
the power window motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 1 of the power window master SW to TERMINALS 3 and 4 to
GROUND, so the motor continues to operate until the driver’s window is fully down.
When the driver’s window finishes down operation and the hold circuit goes off, so the relay (Down side) also turns off. This
stops the current flowing from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW to TERMINAL 5 is cut off, so the
power window motor stops and auto down operation stops.
When the driver’s SW is pulled to the up side during auto down operation, the hold circuit is turned off so the current flowing
from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW to TERMINAL 5 is cut off and the power window motor stops.
If the SW remains pulled up the relay (Up side) is activated, so current flows from TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power
window master SW to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 1 of the power window motor to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 5 to
TERMINALS 3 and 4 to GROUND, the power window motor rotates in the up direction and manual up operation occurs
while the SW is pulled up.
3. MANUAL OPERATION (FRONT RH WINDOW)
With the power window control SW front RH pulled to the up side, the current flowing from TERMINAL 4 of the power window
control SW flows to TERMINAL 3 of the power window control SW to TERMINAL 2 of the power window motor to TERMINAL
1 to TERMINAL 1 of the power window control SW to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 6 of the master SW to TERMINALS 3 and
4 to GROUND and causes the power window motor front RH to rotate in the up direction. The up operation continues only
while the power window control SW is pulled to the up side. When the window descends, the current flowing to the motor
flows in the opposite direction, from TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 2, and the motor rotates in reverse. When the window lock
SW is pushed to the lock side, the ground circuit to the front RH window becomes open.
As a result, even if Open/Close operation of the front RH window is tried, the current from TERMINALS 3 and 4 of the power
window master SW is not grounded and the motor does not rotate, so the front RH window can not be operated and window
lock occurs.
4. MANUAL OPERATION (REAR LH, RH WINDOW)
With the power window control SW rear LH, RH pulled to the up side, the current flowing from TERMINAL 3 of the power
window control SW flows to TERMINAL 1 of the power control SW to TERMINAL 2 of the power window motor to TERMINAL
1 to TERMINAL 5 of the power window control SW to TERMINAL 4 to TERMINAL 12 or 13 of the master SW to TERMINALS
3 and 4 to GROUND and causes the power window motor rear LH, RH to rotate in the up direction. The up operation
continues only while the power window control SW is pulled to the up side. When the window descends, the current flowing
to the motor flows in the opposite direction, from TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 2, and the motor rotates in reverse. When the
window lock SW is pushed to the lock side, the ground circuit to the rear LH, RH window becomes open.
As a result, even if Open/Close operation of the rear LH, RH window is tried, the current from TERMINALS 3 and 4 of the
power window master SW is not grounded and the motor does not rotate, so the rear LH, RH window can not be operated
and window lock occurs.
5. KEY OFF POWER WINDOW OPERATION
With the ignition SW turned from on to off, the integration relay operates and current flows from the DOOR fuse to
TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 12 (w/o theft
deterrent system), (B) 3 (w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 1 of the power relay to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND for about
43 seconds. The same as normal operation, the current flows from the POWER fuse to TERMINAL 5 of the power relay to
TERMINAL 3 to TERMINALS 10 and 11 of the power window master SW and TERMINAL 4 (Front RH) or 3 (Rear LH, RH) of
the power window control SW. As a result, for about 43 seconds after the ignition SW is turned off, the functioning of this
relay makes it possible to raise and lower the power window. Also, by opening the front doors (Door courtesy SW on) within
about 43 seconds after turning the ignition SW to off, a signal is input to TERMINAL 6 or (A) 8 (w/o theft deterrent system),
(B) 6 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration relay. As a result, the relay turned off, and up and down movement of the
power window stops.
SERVICE HINTS
P9 POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
10, 11–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position or key off power window operation
3, 4–GROUND : Always continuity
1–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW on and the master SW (Driver’s window) at UP position
5–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW on and the master SW (Driver’s window)
at DOWN or AUTO DOWN position
WINDOW LOCK SW
Open with the window lock SW at LOCK position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
D12
D13
Code
32
J33
32
J34
See Page
Code
See Page
A
31
P9
33
B
31
P10
33
A
30
J38
32
P11
33
B
30
P6
33
P12
33
J4
31
P7
33
P13
33
J11
31
P8
33
I18
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IE1
IE2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM2
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IN2
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BO1
44
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
44
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
POWER WINDOW
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
B13
44
D12
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Front Door LH Wire
D13
I18 (A)
I18 (B)
(w/o Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
1
(w/ Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
8 1213
1
1 X 3 X 6
X X
X X X X X X X
J4
J11
BLACK
A A A
X X
X
A
A
J33 (A)
J34 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
A A
C C
E E E
D D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J38
P6
(TMC Made) BLACK
A A A
B B
A A A B B B B
P6
P7
P8
12345
12345
(TMMK Made)
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
(Hint : See Page 7)
P9
1 3
4 5 6
8 9 1011121314
P10
P11
P12
P13
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2
MEMO
DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMC MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
1
TO POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW
30A
POWER
25A
DOOR
10A
GAUGE
2
1
1 1D
L–W
5
POWER
RELAY
C B
3
2
12 1G
7 1J
L
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5 1G
3 1M
5 1M
3 A
18 B
4 A
19 B
5 A
20 B
G
L–W
R–G
L
13 A
1 B
I18 A ,
B
INTEGRATION RELAY
7
L–R
G
6
5
F
L–B
3
A
A
A
A
W–B
J38
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
W–B
A
W–B
W–B
J39
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IE2
11
IE1
L–R
8
L–B
IE2
L–R
3
D19
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT LH
1
W–B
D18
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
W–B
1
3
UNLOCK
2
UNLOCK
3
3 IM1
LOCK
4 IM1
L
IE1
R–G
3
UNLOCK
R–G
4 IE1
W–B
F
(* 1)
L(*2)
12 IM1
L–R
G
13 IM1
L
A
LG
A
LG
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
L–W
2
UNLOCK
7
4
B
D16
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
L–W
LOCK
12 IE1
2
B
B
L–W
E
G
P9
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LH
[POWER WINDOW MASTER SW]
LG
LOCK
IE1
B
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
L–W
LOCK
G
E
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
G
LG
LG
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
D
9 A (* 1)
5 B (* 2)
11 B
L–R
2 A
17 B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 A
16 B
13
W–B
12 A (*1)
3 B (*2)
5
LG
10
L–R
U1
UNLOCK WARNING SW
L–B
R–B
1
2
3
4
M
1
W–B
W–B
2
L–W
A A
W–B
20 IM1
W–B
20 IE1
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
W–B
7
1G
3
1V
W–B
W–B
A
IE
IJ
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
1
R–G
R–G
1
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
* 1 : W/O THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
* 2 : W/ THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
R–G
6 IN2
D B
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
E A
I18 A ,
7 1S
B
INTEGRATION RELAY
L–B
L–B(* 1)
6
IF2
L–B
L–Y
E
B
M
D
A
D
A
Y
7 BP1
4 BP1
2
3
1
W–B
3 IM2
2
3
4
M
1
M
4
6 BO1
6 BP1
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BL
B6
W–B
W–B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4
L–Y
J 9 A , J10 B
D21
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR LH
5 BP1
7 IM2
IK
3 IN2
L–Y
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
IF2
D22
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW REAR RH
1
11 IM1
L–Y
J30 A , J31 B
Y
L–Y
3
1
IN2
L–B
L–B
L–B
2
C
L–B
L–R
4 BO1
C
B
C
B
L–Y
7 BO1
L–R
2
5 BO1
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–Y
L–B
L–R
(* 1)
C
L–Y
L–B
L–R
L–B
L–R
2
IN2
L–R
L–B
7
IF2
B
B
B
B
L–R
L–R
L–R
L–R
10 A (* 1)
7 B (*2)
11 A
9 B
Y
L–R
C
A
C
A
C
A
B
A
B
A
B
A
L–Y
7 A
25 B
D20
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW FRONT RH
6 A
12 B
8 A (* 1)
6 B (* 2)
6
BN
DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMC MADE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current always flows to TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration
relay through the DOOR fuse.
When the ignition SW is turned on, the current flowing through the GAUGE Fuse flows to TERMINAL 7 of the integration
relay to TERMINAL (A) 12 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 3 (w/ theft deterrent system) to the power relay (Coil side) to
GROUND.
1. MANUAL LOCK OPERATION
When the door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock SW are operated to LOCK position, a lock signal is input to
TERMINAL (A) 1 or (A) 3 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 16 or (B) 18 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration relay and
causes the relay to function. Current flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent
system) of the relay to (A) 6 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock
motors to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the
relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and the door lock motor causes the door to lock.
2. MANUAL UNLOCK OPERATION
When the door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock SW are operated to UNLOCK position, an unlock signal is input
to TERMINAL (A) 2, (A) 4 or (A) 5 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 17, (B) 19 or (B) 20 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the
integration relay and causes the relay to function. Current flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/
theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25 (w/ theft deterrent
system) to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft Deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/
theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and door lock motors causes door to unlock.
3. DOUBLE OPERATION UNLOCK OPERATION
When the door key lock and unlock SW front LH is turned to the unlock side, only the driver’s door is mechanically unlocked.
Turning the door key lock and unlock SW front LH to the unlock side causes a signal to be input to TERMINAL (A) 4 (w/o
theft deterrent system), (B) 19 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay, and if the signal is input again within 3 seconds by
turning the SW to the unlock side again, current flows from TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25
(w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration relay to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock
motors to TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to
GROUND, causing the door lock motors to operate and unlock the doors.
4. IGNITION KEY REMINDER OPERATION
∗ Operating door lock knob (Operation of door lock motors)
With ignition key in cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), when the door is opened and locked using door lock knob (Door
lock motor), the door is locked once but each door is unlocked soon by the function of the relay. As a result, the current
flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration relay to
TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system),(B) 11 and (B) 25 (w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 3 of the door
lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft
deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and causes all the doors to unlock.
∗ Operating door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock SW
With ignition key in cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), when the door is opened and locked using door lock control SW or
key SW, the door is locked once but each door is unlock by the function of SW contained in motors, which the signal is
input to TERMINAL (A) 9 or (A) 10 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 5 or (B) 7 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay.
According to this input signal, the current in ECU flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/
theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25 (w/ theft deterrent
system) to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft
deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and causes all the doors
to unlock.
∗ In case of key less lock
With ignition key in cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), when the unlock function is disturbed more than 0.2 seconds, for
example pushing the door lock knob etc., the door holds on lock condition. Closing the door after, door courtesy SW
inputs the signal into TERMINAL 6 or (A) 8 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 6 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the
integration relay. By this input signal, the ECU works and current flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent
system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25
(w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock motors to
TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to
GROUND and causes all the doors to unlock.
SERVICE HINTS
I18 (A), (B) INTEGRATION RELAY
10–GROUND : Always continuity
6–GROUND : Continuity with driver’s door open
7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with ignition SW at ON position
(A)13 or (B) 1–GROUND: Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 6 or (B)12–GROUND: Approx. 12 volts 0.2 seconds with following operation
∗ Door lock control SW locked
∗ Locking driver’s, front passenger’s door cylinder with key
(A) 1or (B)16–GROUND : Continuity with door lock control SW locked
(A) 8 or (B) 6–GROUND : Continuity with front passenger’s door open
(A) 9 or (B) 5–GROUND : Continuity with driver’s door lock knob unlocked
(A)10 or (B) 7–GROUND: Continuity with front passenger’s door lock knob unlock
(A) 2 or (B)17–GROUND: Continuity with door lock control SW unlocked
(A) 5 or (B)20–GROUND: Continuity with front passenger’s door lock cylinder unlocked with key
(A) 4 or (B)19–GROUND: Continuity with driver’s door lock cylinder unlocked with key
(A) 3 or (B)18–GROUND: Continuity with driver’s, front passenger’s door lock cylinder locked with key
(A) 7 or (B)11, (B)25–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts 0.2 seconds with following operation
∗ Door lock control SW unlocked
∗ Door lock control SW locked with ignition key in cylinder and driver’s door open
(Ignition key reminder function)
∗ Door lock knob locked with ignition key in cylinder and driver’s door open
(Ignition key reminder function)
∗ Unlocking driver’s, front passenger’s door cylinder with key
D12, D13 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH,RH
1–GROUND : Closed with each door open
D16, D17 DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SW FRONT LH,RH
1–2 : Closed with door lock cylinder locked with key
1–3 : Closed with door lock cylinder unlocked with key
D19, D20 DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SW FRONT LH,RH
1–4 : Closed with door lock knob UNLOCK position
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
1–2 : Closed with ignition key in cylinder
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
D12
32
D13
32
D16
32
D17
32
J9
D18
32
J10
D19
32
D20
32
J30
D21
32
D22
32
See Page
Code
A
30
B
30
J37
31
31
J38
32
A
31
J39
32
B
31
J40
32
31
P9
33
A
31
U1
31
J31
B
31
J33
A
31
I18
J6
J11
J34
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
1J
1M
See Page
B
31
DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMC MADE)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
IE1
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IN2
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BO1
44
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
44
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
IE2
IF2
IM1
IM2
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
40
Right Kick Panel
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
IJ
IK
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
B6
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor No.2 Wire
D12
D13
D16
D17
D18
D19
BLACK
1
X
X
3X5 6
1
1
2
3
1
2
3
1 2 3 4
D20
D21
D22
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
(w/o Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
I18 (A)
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
J6
I18 (B)
(w/ Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
1 X 3 X 5 6
7 X 9 X 11
12 X X X 16 17 18 19 20 X X X X 25
J9 (A)
BLACK
B B B B
DD DE E E F F F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
D D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
J10 (B)
J11
BLACK
A
A
J30 (A)
J31 (B)
GRAY
GRAY
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J33 (A)
J34 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
J37
A A
C C
E E E
D D D
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
J38
A A A
A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J39
A A A
X X
A A A X X X X
J40
A
A
P9
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
2
4
7
U1
1 2
DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMMK MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
1
TO POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW
30A
POWER
25A
DOOR
10A
GAUGE
2
1
1 1D
L–W
5
POWER
RELAY
C B
3
2
12 1G
7 1J
L
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5 1G
3 1M
5 1M
3 A
18 B
4 A
19 B
5 A
20 B
G
L–W
R–G
L
I18 A ,
B
INTEGRATION RELAY
7
L–R
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5
F
L–B
(* 1)
L(*2)
G
G
6
L–R
LG
12 IM1
W–B
W–B
7
1G
3
1V
W–B
UNLOCK
W–B
W–B
IE
IE1
L–R
11
L–B
IE2
L–R
8
2
3
4
M
1
20 IM1
A
IE2
B14
W–B
W–B
B13
3
3
D19
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT LH
1
W–B
D18
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
W–B
1
3
UNLOCK
2
UNLOCK
3
3 IM1
LOCK
4 IM1
L
IE1
R–G
3
20 IE1
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
13 IM1
L
A
LG
A
F
R–G
4 IE1
W–B
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–W
2
UNLOCK
7
B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
D16
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
L–W
LOCK
12 IE1
4
B
B
L–W
E
G
P9
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LH
[POWER WINDOW MASTER SW]
LG
LOCK
IE1
B
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
L–W
LOCK
G
E
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
G
LG
D
LG
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
9 A (* 1)
5 B (* 2)
11 B
D
2
IG
13 A
1 B
L–R
2 A
17 B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 A
16 B
13
W–B
12 A (*1)
3 B (*2)
5
LG
10
L–R
U1
UNLOCK WARNING SW
L–B
R–B
1
IJ
W–B
W–B
2
L–W
A A
W–B
W–B
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
1
R–G
R–G
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
1
* 1 : W/O THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
* 2 : W/ THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
R–G
6 IN2
D B
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
E A
I18 A ,
7 1S
B
INTEGRATION RELAY
L–B
L–B(* 1)
6
IF2
L–B
L–Y
E
B
M
D
A
D
A
Y
7 BP1
4 BP1
2
3
1
W–B
3 IM2
2
3
1
M
4
M
4
6 BO1
6 BP1
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BL
B6
W–B
W–B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4
L–Y
J 9 A , J10 B
D21
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR LH
5 BP1
7 IM2
IK
3 IN2
L–Y
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
IF2
D22
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW REAR RH
1
11 IM1
L–Y
J30 A , J31 B
Y
L–Y
3
1
IN2
L–B
L–B
L–B
2
C
L–B
L–R
4 BO1
C
B
C
B
L–Y
7 BO1
L–R
2
5 BO1
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–Y
L–B
L–R
(* 1)
C
L–Y
L–B
L–R
L–B
L–R
2
IN2
L–R
L–B
7
IF2
B
B
B
B
L–R
L–R
L–R
L–R
10 A (* 1)
7 B (*2)
11 A
9 B
Y
L–R
C
A
C
A
C
A
B
A
B
A
B
A
L–Y
7 A
25 B
D20
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW FRONT RH
6 A
12 B
8 A (* 1)
6 B (* 2)
6
BN
DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMMK MADE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current always flows to TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration
relay through the DOOR fuse.
When the ignition SW is turned on, the current flowing through the GAUGE Fuse flows to TERMINAL 7 of the integration
relay to TERMINAL (A) 12 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 3 (w/ theft deterrent system) to the power relay (Coil side) to
GROUND.
1. MANUAL LOCK OPERATION
When the door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock SW are operated to LOCK position, a lock signal is input to
TERMINAL (A) 1 or (A) 3 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 16 or (B) 18 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration relay and
causes the relay to function. Current flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent
system) of the relay to (A) 6 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock
motors to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the
relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and the door lock motor causes the door to lock.
2. MANUAL UNLOCK OPERATION
When the door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock SW are operated to UNLOCK position, an unlock signal is input
to TERMINAL (A) 2, (A) 4 or (A) 5 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 17, (B) 19 or (B) 20 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the
integration relay and causes the relay to function. Current flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1
(w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25 (w/ theft deterrent
system) to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft Deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/
theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and door lock motors causes door to unlock.
3. DOUBLE OPERATION UNLOCK OPERATION
When the door key lock and unlock SW front LH is turned to the unlock side, only the driver’s door is mechanically unlocked.
Turning the door key lock and unlock SW front LH to the unlock side causes a signal to be input to TERMINAL (A) 4 (w/o
theft deterrent system), (B) 19 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay, and if the signal is input again within 3 seconds by
turning the SW to the unlock side again, current flows from TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25
(w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration relay to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock
motors to TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to
GROUND, causing the door lock motors to operate and unlock the doors.
4. IGNITION KEY REMINDER OPERATION
∗ Operating door lock knob (Operation of door lock motors)
With ignition key in cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), when the door is opened and locked using door lock knob (Door
lock motor), the door is locked once but each door is unlocked soon by the function of the relay. As a result, the current
flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration relay to
TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system),(B) 11 and (B) 25 (w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 3 of the door
lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft
deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and causes all the doors to unlock.
∗ Operating door lock control SW or door key lock and unlock SW
With ignition key in cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), when the door is opened and locked using door lock control SW or
key SW, the door is locked once but each door is unlock by the function of SW contained in motors, which the signal is
input to TERMINAL (A) 9 or (A) 10 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 5 or (B) 7 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay.
According to this input signal, the current in ECU flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/
theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25 (w/ theft deterrent
system) to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft
deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and causes all the doors
to unlock.
∗ In case of key less lock
With ignition key in cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), when the unlock function is disturbed more than 0.2 seconds, for
example pushing the door lock knob etc., the door holds on lock condition. Closing the door after, door courtesy SW
inputs the signal into TERMINAL 6 or (A) 8 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 6 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the
integration relay. By this input signal, the ECU works and current flows from TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent
system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 7 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 11 and (B) 25
(w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 3 of the door lock motors to TERMINAL 2 of the door lock motors to
TERMINAL (A) 6 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 12 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to
GROUND and causes all the doors to unlock.
SERVICE HINTS
I18 (A), (B) INTEGRATION RELAY
10–GROUND : Always continuity
6–GROUND : Continuity with driver’s door open
7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with ignition SW at ON position
(A)13 or (B) 1–GROUND: Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 6 or (B)12–GROUND:Approx. 12 volts 0.2 seconds with following operation
∗ Door lock control SW locked
∗ Locking driver’s, front passenger’s door cylinder with key
(A) 1 or (B)16–GROUND: Continuity with door lock control SW locked
(A) 8 or (B) 6–GROUND : Continuity with front passenger’s door open
(A) 9 or (B) 5–GROUND : Continuity with driver’s door lock knob unlocked
(A)10 or (B) 7–GROUND: Continuity with front passenger’s door lock knob unlock
(A) 2 or (B)17–GROUND: Continuity with door lock control SW unlocked
(A) 5 or (B)20–GROUND: Continuity with front passenger’s door lock cylinder unlocked with key
(A) 4 or (B)19–GROUND: Continuity with driver’s door lock cylinder unlocked with key
(A) 3 or (B)18–GROUND: Continuity with driver’s, front passenger’s door lock cylinder locked with key
(A) 7 or (B)11, (B)25–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts 0.2 seconds with following operation
∗ Door lock control SW unlocked
∗ Door lock control SW locked with ignition key in cylinder and driver’s door open
(Ignition key reminder function)
∗ Door lock knob locked with ignition key in cylinder and driver’s door open
(Ignition key reminder function)
∗ Unlocking driver’s, front passenger’s door cylinder with key
D12, D13 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH,RH
1–GROUND : Closed with each door open
D16, D17 DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SW FRONT LH,RH
1–2 : Closed with door lock cylinder locked with key
1–3 : Closed with door lock cylinder unlocked with key
D19, D20 DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SW FRONT LH,RH
1–4 : Closed with door lock knob UNLOCK position
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
1–2 : Closed with ignition key in cylinder
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
D12
32
D13
32
D16
32
D17
32
D18
32
J9
D19
32
J10
D20
32
D21
32
See Page
D22
I18
32
J31
B
31
30
J33
A
31
B
30
J34
B
31
31
J37
31
A
31
J40
32
B
31
P9
33
31
U1
31
J11
A
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
1J
1M
See Page
A
J6
J30
Code
DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMMK MADE)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
IE1
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IN2
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BO1
44
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
44
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
IE2
IF2
IM1
IM2
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
40
Right Kick Panel
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
IJ
IK
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
B6
44
See Page
Floor No.2 Wire
B14
B13
44
Front Door LH Wire
D12
D13
1
D16
See Page
44
D17
1
1
2
3
Front Door RH Wire
D18
D19
BLACK
BLACK
X
1
2
3
Wire Harness with Splice Points
X
1 2 3 4
3 X 5 6
D20
D21
D22
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
(w/o Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10111213
I18 (B)
I18 (A)
J6
(w/ Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
1 X 3 X 5 6
7 X 9 X 11
12 X X X 16 17 18 19 20 X X X X 25
J9 (A)
BLACK
B B B B
DD DE E E F F F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
D D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
J10 (B)
J11
BLACK
A
A
J30 (A)
J31 (B)
GRAY
GRAY
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J33 (A)
J34 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
A A
C C
E E E
D D D
J37
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
P9
2
4
7
(Hint : See Page 7)
U1
1 2
J40
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
1
D B
8 IN2
6 IN2
1
A A
E A
E A
1 A
BATTERY
D B
2
1
D B
1
J16 A , J17 B
10 IG1
R–W
1
E B
D A
D A
D A
R–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J33 A , J34 B
R–W
E B
R–W
L–W
R–W
2
R–W
R
R–Y
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
C B
J33 A , J34 B
8 1S
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–W
R
G–R
7. 5A DOME
25A
DOOR
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
E A
R
B B
C B
R–W
B A
J33 A , J34 B
B A
L–W
10A
TAIL
L–W
1 1D
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
6 1C
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
R–G
A
R–G
G–R
G–R
3
J33 A , J34 B
G–R
G
G–O
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
TO TAILLIGHTS
TO FRONT PARKING
LIGHTS
B–R
5
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
B–R
B–R
E3
R–W
1 F
9 1C
R–W
100A ALT
4 1B
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
B–G
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMC MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
G–R
1
L–W
R
2
R–W
12 2J
1 1W
8 1G
D10
DIODE
(DOME)
1
R–W
R
G–R
2 F
F4 A , F9 F
L–W
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
R–W
R–G
D7
DIODE (COURTESY)
R–W
R–G
R–G
G–R
G–R
L–W
L–W
R
R
R–W
R–W
14
8
4
W6
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK ECU
9
10
L
V
G–R
R
R–W
L–R
R–G
L–W
L–B
2
R–W
R–G
L–W
INTEGRATION RELAY
11 B
18 B
B A
B A
L–B
J 9 A , J10 B
L–R
19 B
L
12 B
I18 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–B
B B
R6
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
7 1D
5
R
25 B
L–B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
D
E
G–R
1 1G
R–G
R–G
R–W
R–W
E
D
R–W
G
LG
G
13 IM1
12 IM1
LG
G
7
D18
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW RH
LOCK
5
6
UNLOCK
2
12 IE1
G
LG
IE1
P9
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LH
[POWER WINDOW MASTER SW]
LG
LOCK
R–G
E
2
13
R–W
1
4
3
3 1M
7 1J
W–B
7 1S
UNLOCK
4 1G 12 1S
L–W
L–B
17 B
6
U1
UNLOCK WARNING SW
W–B
16 B
G
4
LG
5 1M
1 B
L–B
L–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
R–G
R–G
R–G
A
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
20
IE1
IE
A
J39
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR A
A
20 IM1
3 1V
IJ
A
A
1
3
IE2
4
2
3
M
11 IM1
7 IM2
3 IM2
L–B
8 IE2
L–R
A
B
C A
C A
C A
F
L–R
B B
B B
4
2
3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
J30 A , J31 B
Y
L–R
L–R
Y
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
Y
L–R
F
D20
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW FRONT RH
L–R
11
W–B
7 1G
11 IE1
L
3 IM1
L–R
A
L–B
2
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
L–R
4 IM1
L–R
L–W
15
L–R
B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
L–W
B
D19
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW FRONT LH
B
L
L
B
L–W
A
L
L–W
L
1
UNLOCK
R–G
7
W–B
W–B
2
W–B
4 IE1
L–W
R–G
L–W
B
W–B
L–W
L–W
W–B
3
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
L–W
LOCK
LOCK
3 IE1
R–G
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR A
A
W–B
B
W–B
W–B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
D16
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
R–G
UNLOCK
L
W–B
W–B
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMC MADE)
G–R
G–R
L–W
L–W
R
R
R–W
R–W
W6
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK ECU
12
L–R
L–R
C
C
3
L–R
L–B
1
M
1
Y
L–R
R–G
L–B
L–W
L–B
L–B
W–B
L
W–B
L–B
R–G
R–G
R–G
R–G
G–R
G–R
L–W
L–W
R
R
R–W
R–W
LG
L–Y
L–R
L–R
L–B
L–B
L–Y
L–R
L–Y
L–R
2
L–B
3
6 BO1
7 BO1
6
M
4
3
L–B
D22
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW REAR RH
1
L–R
5 BP1
6 BP1
7 BP1
W–B
B A
4
W–B
J30 A , J31 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B A
2 IN2
4 BP1
M
W–B
L–B
C B
D21
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW REAR LH
L–Y
L–B
C B
3 IN2
5 BO1
2
L–Y
L–R
IF2
1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E B
7
4 BO1
J 9 A , J10 B
E B
IF2
L–Y
2
L–R
D A
L–Y
D A
L–Y
L–B
L–Y
L–R
LG
IF2
L–B
W–B
5
L–Y
1
W–B
W–B
13
L–Y
W6
WIRELESS DOOR
LOCK ECU
1 IN2
W–B
L–B
B6
L–B
L–B
Y
Y
L–R
L–R
R–G
R–G
L–W
L–W
L–B
L–B
L–B
R–G
R–G
R–G
R–G
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BL
BN
W–B
L
W–B
L
IK
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMC MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
G–R
L–W
1
R
15A
ECU–IG
R–W
10A
HORN
40A
MAIN
LG
2
L–Y
8 1D
1
5
4
1
3
2
W–B
B–R
HORN
RELAY
HEAD
RELAY
2
3
10 2K
8 2K
12 B
SH
T3 B , T4 A
B
10 B
R–B
A B
C A
HEAD
7 IG3
L–R
* 1 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 2 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
R–G
L–W
L
L–B
R–G
W–B
R–G
IF
R–B
DSWP
5 A
J 9 A , J10 B
L–B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
DSWD
4 A
R–G
L
KSW
6 A
L–W
UL2
10 A
R–G
L2
8 A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Y
W–B
A
UL3
9 A
W–B
A
A
LSWD
14 A
L–R
LSWP
15 A
Y
E
7 B
R–G
THEFT DETERRENT ECU
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
R
(*2)
R–B
B
HORN
J 1 (*1) ,
J32 (*2)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
9 B
IG
11 IG1
(* 1)
13 A
TAIL
H
5
R–B
11 B
+B2
(* 1)
G–B
G–B
1 B
+B1
6
H–LP
G–B
5 IG3
W–L
R
CTY
B–R
R–W
11 A
PANI
G–R
LG
1 A
LSWR
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–L
4 IK1
L–W
L–Y
18 A
W–B
16 A
C
C
W–L
A B
1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C A
J16 A , J17 B
2
T1
THEFT DETERRENT
HORN
W
3 2F
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Door lock control (Lock and unlock) and panic control (Theft alarm and flash) is performed by remote control, without the
ignition key inserted in the door key cylinder, using low–power electrical waves emitted by a transmitter.
1. WIRELESS DOOR LOCK OR UNLOCK NORMAL OPERATION
With the ignition key not inserted into the ignition key cylinder (Unlock warning SW off) and all the doors completely closed,
when the lock or unlock button (Transmitter) is pushed, the wireless door lock ECU receives the electrical waves from the
transmitter, causing it to operate.
As a result, the ECU judges whether the door is locked or unlocked based on the signal from the door lock motor and door
unlock detection SW, and sends a signal to the theft deterrent ECU and integration relay to switch the condition from lock to
unlock or vice versa, causing the door lock motor to operate.
2. VISUAL CONFIRMATION OF LOCK OR UNLOCK
If all doors indicate that they are locked after the lock command, parking lights and taillight will flash once. If any door
indicates that it is open after the unlock command, parking lights and taillights will flash twice.
3. WIRELESS DOOR UNLOCK OPERATION
Pushing the unlock button (Transmitter) once, driver’s door is unlocked. Furthermore, pushing the button again within 3
seconds, the other doors are unlocked.
4. AUTOMATIC LOCK OPERATION
With the ignition key not inserted into the ignition key cylinder (Unlock warning SW off) and all the doors completely closed,
after pushing the button (Transmitter) to unlock all the doors, if a door is not opened within 30 seconds, all the doors will be
automatically relocked.
5. WIRELESS CONTROL STOP FUNCTION
If a door is open (Door courtesy SW on), a signal is input from the door courtesy SW to the wireless door lock ECU, stopping
wireless door lock or unlock.
If the ignition key is in the ignition key cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), the unlock warning SW inputs a signal to the
wireless door lock ECU, stopping wireless door lock or unlock.
6. DOOR LOCK MOTOR PROTECTIVE FUNCTION
If the door lock or unlock condition does not change after wireless door lock or unlock operation, 2 seconds later, the
integration relay ECU sends current three times to the door lock motor. If the door lock condition still has not changed as a
result, the wireless door lock ECU stops reception and stops door lock and unlock function.
7. REMOTE PANIC OPERATION
Panic will function when doors are locked or unlocked, open or closed. When the panic button (Transmitter) is pushed once,
theft alarm sounds and headlights and taillight flash. Then, the panic or the unlock button (Transmitter) is pushed once more,
sounding and flashing will stop. Panic will not function when ignition key is in ignition key cylinder.
SERVICE HINTS
D12, D13, D14, D15 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH, RH, REAR LH, RH
1–GROUND : Continuity with the door open
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
2–1 : Continuity with the ignition key in the cylinder
W6 WIRELESS DOOR LOCK ECU
8–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
1–GROUND : Always continuity
14–GROUND : Continuity with each of the door open
10–GROUND : Continuity with the ignition key in the cylinder
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMC MADE)
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
D6
30
D7
30
D10
30
D12
32
D13
32
D14
Code
See Page
F4
A
F9
F
I18
B
Code
28 (5S–FE)
See Page
J32
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J33
A
31
28 (5S–FE)
J34
B
31
30
J37
31
J1
31
J38
32
32
J2
31
J39
32
D15
32
J5
31
J40
32
D16
32
J6
31
P9
33
D17
32
J9
A
31
R6
31
D18
32
J10
B
31
D19
32
D20
32
J16
A
31
T3
B
31
D21
32
J17
B
31
T4
A
31
32
J30
A
31
U1
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J31
B
31
W6
31
D22
F4
A
J11
27 (1MZ–FE)
T1
31
29 (5S–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1B
1C
1D
1G
1J
1M
1S
1V
1W
2F
2J
2K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IE1
IE2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF2
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG1
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK1
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IM1
IM2
IN2
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BO1
44
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
44
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
40
Right Kick Panel
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
IJ
IK
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
E3
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
B6
Cowl Wire
38 (5S–FE)
D6
D7
D10
GRAY
BLACK
BLACK
1 2
1 2
X
X X
X X
D15
6
7
X
D16
D17
1
1
2
3
1
2
3
D21
D22
BLACK
BLACK
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
D18
X
X
3X5 6
F4 (A)
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
44
Floor No.2 Wire
D12
D13
D14
1
1
1
D19
D20
BLACK
BLACK
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
F9 (F)
ORANGE
1
1
J1
I18 (B)
ORANGE
1 X X
X X 11
B
B B B B
12 X X X 16 17 18 19 X X X X 25
(Hint : See Page 7)
2
J2
J5
BLACK
ORANGE
A A A
CCC
(Hint : See Page 7)
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMC MADE)
J9 (A)
J10 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
B B C C
A A B B
D D D
E E E
J6
B B B B
DD DE E E F F F F
J11
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J16 (A)
J17 (B)
J30 (A)
J31 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
C C
A A
E E E
D D D
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J32
J33 (A)
J34 (B)
GRAY
BLACK
BLACK
A A B B
B B C C
D D D E E E
D D D E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
B
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
J37
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
J38
J39
A A A
A A A
A A A
X X
A A A X X X X
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J40
A
A
P9
A
A
A
2
4
7
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
T1
R6
T3 (B)
T4 (A)
1 X X X X
1 4 5 6 8 9 10 11
7 X 9 10 11 12
X 13 14 15 16 X 18 X X X X
BLACK
X X
1 2
U1
W6
BLUE
1 2
1 X X 4
8 9
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
2
A
10 11 12 13
5 X 7
14 15
MEMO
1
D B
8 IN2
6 IN2
1
A A
E A
E A
1 A
BATTERY
D B
2
1
D B
1
J16 A , J17 B
10 IG1
R–W
1
E B
D A
D A
D A
R–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J33 A , J34 B
R–W
E B
R–W
L–W
R–W
2
R–W
R
R–Y
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
C B
J33 A , J34 B
8 1S
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–W
R
G–R
7. 5A DOME
25A
DOOR
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
E A
R
B B
C B
R–W
B A
J33 A , J34 B
B A
L–W
10A
TAIL
L–W
1 1D
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
6 1C
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
R–G
A
R–G
G–R
G–R
3
J33 A , J34 B
G–R
G
G–O
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
TO TAILLIGHTS
TO FRONT PARKING
LIGHTS
B–R
5
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
B–R
B–R
E3
R–W
1 F
9 1C
R–W
100A ALT
4 1B
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
B–G
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMMK MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
G–R
1
L–W
R
2
R–W
12 2J
1 1W
8 1G
D10
DIODE
(DOME)
1
R–W
R
G–R
2 F
F4 A , F9 F
L–W
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
R–W
R–G
D7
DIODE (COURTESY)
R–W
R–G
R–G
G–R
G–R
L–W
L–W
R
R
R–W
R–W
14
8
4
W6
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK ECU
9
10
L
V
G–R
R
R–W
L–R
R–G
L–W
L–B
2
R–W
R–G
L–W
INTEGRATION RELAY
11 B
18 B
B A
B A
L–B
J 9 A , J10 B
L–R
19 B
L
12 B
I18 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–B
B B
R6
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
7 1D
5
R
25 B
L–B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
D
E
G–R
1 1G
R–G
R–G
R–W
R–W
E
D
R–W
G
LG
G
13 IM1
12 IM1
LG
G
7
D18
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW RH
LOCK
5
6
UNLOCK
2
12 IE1
G
LG
IE1
P9
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LH
[POWER WINDOW MASTER SW]
LG
LOCK
R–G
E
2
13
R–W
1
4
3
3 1M
7 1J
W–B
7 1S
UNLOCK
4 1G 12 1S
L–W
L–B
17 B
6
U1
UNLOCK WARNING SW
W–B
16 B
G
4
LG
5 1M
1 B
L–B
L–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
R–G
R–G
R–G
A
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
20
IE1
IE
B14
20 IM1
3 1V
IJ
1
3
IE2
4
2
3
M
11 IM1
7 IM2
3 IM2
L–B
8 IE2
L–R
A
B
C A
C A
C A
F
L–R
B B
B B
1
2
3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
J30 A , J31 B
Y
L–R
L–R
Y
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
Y
L–R
L–R
11
W–B
7 1G
F
D20
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW FRONT RH
11 IE1
L
3 IM1
L–R
A
L–B
2
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
L–R
4 IM1
L–R
L–W
15
L–R
B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
L–W
B
D19
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW FRONT LH
B
L
L
B
L–W
B13
L
L–W
L
1
UNLOCK
R–G
7
W–B
W–B
2
W–B
4 IE1
L–W
R–G
L–W
B
W–B
L–W
L–W
W–B
3
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
L–W
LOCK
LOCK
3 IE1
R–G
W–B
B
W–B
W–B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–G
R–G
W–B
W–B
D16
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
R–G
UNLOCK
L
W–B
W–B
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMMK MADE)
G–R
G–R
L–W
L–W
R
R
R–W
R–W
W6
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK ECU
12
L–R
L–R
C
C
3
L–R
L–B
1
M
4
Y
L–R
R–G
L–B
L–W
L–B
L–B
W–B
L
W–B
L–B
R–G
R–G
R–G
R–G
G–R
G–R
L–W
L–W
R
R
R–W
R–W
LG
L–Y
L–R
L–R
L–B
L–B
L–Y
L–R
L–Y
L–R
2
L–B
3
6 BO1
7 BO1
6
M
4
3
L–B
D22
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW REAR RH
1
L–R
5 BP1
6 BP1
7 BP1
W–B
B A
4
W–B
J30 A , J31 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B A
2 IN2
4 BP1
M
W–B
L–B
C B
D21
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND DOOR
UNLOCK DETECTION SW REAR LH
L–Y
L–B
C B
3 IN2
5 BO1
2
L–Y
L–R
IF2
1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E B
7
4 BO1
J 9 A , J10 B
E B
IF2
L–Y
2
L–R
D A
L–Y
D A
L–Y
L–B
L–Y
L–R
LG
IF2
L–B
W–B
5
L–Y
1
W–B
W–B
13
L–Y
W6
WIRELESS DOOR
LOCK ECU
1 IN2
W–B
L–B
B6
L–B
L–B
Y
Y
L–R
L–R
R–G
R–G
L–W
L–W
L–B
L–B
L–B
R–G
R–G
R–G
R–G
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BL
BN
W–B
L
W–B
L
IK
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMMK MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
G–R
L–W
1
R
15A
ECU–IG
R–W
10A
HORN
40A
MAIN
LG
2
L–Y
8 1D
1
5
4
1
3
2
W–B
B–R
HORN
RELAY
HEAD
RELAY
2
3
10 2K
8 2K
12 B
SH
B
HORN
T3 B , T4 A
B
L–R
10 B
R–B
A B
C A
HEAD
R–B
DSWP
5 A
J 9 A , J10 B
L–B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
DSWD
4 A
R–G
L
KSW
6 A
L–W
UL2
10 A
R–G
L2
8 A
7 IG3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Y
W–B
A
UL3
9 A
W–B
A
A
LSWD
14 A
L–R
LSWP
15 A
Y
E
7 B
R–G
THEFT DETERRENT ECU
* 1 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 2 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
R–G
L–W
L
L–B
R–G
W–B
R–G
IF
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
R
(*2)
R–B
11 IG1
J 1 (*1) ,
J32 (*2)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
9 B
IG
H
2
(* 1)
13 A
TAIL
H–LP
R–B
11 B
+B2
(* 1)
G–B
G–B
1 B
+B1
19
G–B
5 IG3
W–L
R
CTY
B–R
R–W
11 A
PANI
G–R
LG
1 A
LSWR
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–L
4 IK1
L–W
L–Y
18 A
W–B
16 A
C
C
W–L
A B
1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C A
J16 A , J17 B
2
T1
THEFT DETERRENT
HORN
W
3 2F
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Door lock control (Lock and unlock) and panic control (Theft alarm and flash) is performed by remote control, without the
ignition key inserted in the door key cylinder, using low–power electrical waves emitted by a transmitter.
1. WIRELESS DOOR LOCK OR UNLOCK NORMAL OPERATION
With the ignition key not inserted into the ignition key cylinder (Unlock warning SW off) and all the doors completely closed,
when the lock or unlock button (Transmitter) is pushed, the wireless door lock ECU receives the electrical waves from the
transmitter, causing it to operate.
As a result, the ECU judges whether the door is locked or unlocked based on the signal from the door lock motor and door
unlock detection SW, and sends a signal to the theft deterrent ECU and integration relay to switch the condition from lock to
unlock or vice versa, causing the door lock motor to operate.
2. VISUAL CONFIRMATION OF LOCK OR UNLOCK
If all doors indicate that they are locked after the lock command, parking lights and taillight will flash once. If any door
indicates that it is open after the unlock command, parking lights and taillights will flash twice.
3. WIRELESS DOOR UNLOCK OPERATION
Pushing the unlock button (Transmitter) once, driver’s door is unlocked. Furthermore, pushing the button again within 3
seconds, the other doors are unlocked.
4. AUTOMATIC LOCK OPERATION
With the ignition key not inserted into the ignition key cylinder (Unlock warning SW off) and all the doors completely closed,
after pushing the button (Transmitter) to unlock all the doors, if a door is not opened within 30 seconds, all the doors will be
automatically relocked.
5. WIRELESS CONTROL STOP FUNCTION
If a door is open (Door courtesy SW on), a signal is input from the door courtesy SW to the wireless door lock ECU, stopping
wireless door lock or unlock.
If the ignition key is in the ignition key cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), the unlock warning SW inputs a signal to the
wireless door lock ECU, stopping wireless door lock or unlock.
6. DOOR LOCK MOTOR PROTECTIVE FUNCTION
If the door lock or unlock condition does not change after wireless door lock or unlock operation, 2 seconds later, the
integration relay ECU sends current three times to the door lock motor. If the door lock condition still has not changed as a
result, the wireless door lock ECU stops reception and stops door lock and unlock function.
7. REMOTE PANIC OPERATION
Panic will function when doors are locked or unlocked, open or closed. When the panic button (Transmitter) is pushed once,
theft alarm sounds and headlights and taillight flash. Then, the panic or the unlock button (Transmitter) is pushed once more,
sounding and flashing will stop. Panic will not function when ignition key is in ignition key cylinder.
SERVICE HINTS
D12, D13, D14, D15 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH, RH, REAR LH, RH
1–GROUND : Continuity with the door open
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
2–1 : Continuity with the ignition key in the cylinder
W6 WIRELESS DOOR LOCK ECU
8–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
1–GROUND : Always continuity
14–GROUND : Continuity with each of the door open
10–GROUND : Continuity with the ignition key in the cylinder
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMMK MADE)
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
D6
30
D7
30
D10
30
D12
32
D13
32
D14
Code
See Page
F4
A
F9
F
I18
B
Code
28 (5S–FE)
See Page
J32
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J33
A
31
28 (5S–FE)
J34
B
31
30
J37
31
J1
31
J40
32
32
J2
31
P9
33
D15
32
J5
31
R6
31
D16
32
J6
31
D17
32
J9
A
31
D18
32
J10
B
31
T3
B
31
D19
32
31
T4
A
31
D20
32
J16
A
31
U1
31
D21
32
J17
B
31
W6
31
32
J30
A
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J31
B
31
D22
F4
A
J11
27 (1MZ–FE)
T1
29 (5S–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1B
1C
1D
1G
1J
1M
1S
1V
1W
2F
2J
2K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IE1
IE2
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF2
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG1
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK1
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IM1
IM2
IN2
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BO1
44
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
44
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
40
Right Kick Panel
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
IJ
IK
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
B6
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
Cowl Wire
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
B13
44
Front Door LH Wire
B14
44
Front Door RH Wire
Floor No.2 Wire
D6
X 2
D7
D10
BLACK
BLACK
1 2
1 2
D12
D13
D14
1
1
1
X X X X X
19 X X
D15
D16
D17
1
D18
D19
D20
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
X
1
2
3
1
2
3
D21
D22
BLACK
BLACK
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
X
3 X 5 6
F9 (F)
F4 (A)
ORANGE
1
I18 (B)
1
J1
ORANGE
1 X X
X X 11
B
B B B B
12 X X X 16 17 18 19 X X X X 25
(Hint : See Page 7)
2
J2
J5
BLACK
ORANGE
A A A
CCC
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL (TMMK MADE)
J9 (A)
J10 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
B B C C
A A B B
D D D
E E E
J6
B B B B
DD DE E E F F F F
J11
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J16 (A)
J17 (B)
J30 (A)
J31 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
C C
A A
E E E
D D D
B B B C C C
B B B C C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J32
J33 (A)
J34 (B)
GRAY
BLACK
BLACK
A A B B
B B C C
D D D E E E
D D D E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
J37
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
J40
P9
T1
R6
BLACK
A
A
A
A
A
2
4
7
A
2
X X
1 2
(Hint : See Page 7)
T3 (B)
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
B
B B B
A
T4 (A)
U1
W6
BLUE
1 X X X X
1 4 5 6 8 9 10 11
7 X 9 10 11 12
X 13 14 15 16 X 18 X X X X
1 2
1 X X 4
8 9
1011 1213
5 X 7
14 15
MEMO
THEFT DETERRENT (TMC MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
1
1
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
5
40A
MAIN
3
2
2
6 1C
1
4
HEAD
RELAY
A
2
3
A
8 2K
G–R
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
4 1B
J 1 (* 1)
J32 (* 2)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
R–B
10 IG1
6
J33 A
G–R
R–B
5
H–LP
H
5
E3
11 B
10 B
PANI
A B
2
R–W
D A
D A
6
D A
R–G
R–W
R–W
D7
DIODE
(COURTESY)
1
2
E A
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–W
B–G
1
C A
J9 A
7 B
E B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
U1
UNLOCK
WARNING SW
R–Y
L–B
5 1M
1 A
E
5 A
W–B
B A
J 9 A , J10 B
B A
R–G
F4 A , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
7 1D
DSWP
1 A
R–G
L–B
L–B
2 F
CTY
DSWD
4 A
R–G
KSW
6 A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
DSWL
2 A
100A ALT
18 A
HEAD
T3 B , T4 A
THEFT DETERRENT ECU
B–R
E A
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF1
3 1M
1 1G
4 1G
D B
4
R–G
IG
1
R–G
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
1
W–B
1
6 IN2
R–W
R–G
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
8 IN2
D13
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT RH
A
12 1S
D14
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR LH
1
INTEGRATION
RELAY
D15
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR RH
7 1S
R–W
7 1J
W–B
L6
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
BATTERY
R–Y
6
D12
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
B–R
TAIL
1 F
LG
7 IG3
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
R–B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W6
WIRELESS DOOR
LOCK ECU
B
A
(*1)
R
B
A
R–B
B
(*1)
B–R
G–R
(* 2)
IF
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
7. 5A
DOME
1 1D
8 1D
12 2J
5
HORN
RELAY
2
R
1
15A
ECU–IG
B–R
25A
DOOR
L–W
10A
HORN
1 1W
3
8 1G
G–B
* 1 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 2 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
C
G–B
C
B
W–L
C
B
12 B
A
C
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
B
D B
D
A
E A
1 IG3
3 1V
J39
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
6 BO1
20 IM1
A
IE
IJ
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BL
B
L–Y
B
D22
DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR RH
4
6 BP1
5
2
IF1
2
1
1
2
B6
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
IE1
1
BR
W–B
A
IK1
E6
ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SW
W–B
A
3
BN
IK
EB
IH
J33 A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
4
W–B
A
4 BP1
L–Y
W–B
1
D21
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW REAR LH
W–B
1
9
3 IN2
L–Y
4 BO1
A
A
IF2
W–B
1
2
L–Y
L
4
UNLOCK
3
A
7 1G
20
2
11 IM1
D20
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT RH
W–B
Y
1
3 IM1
W–B
2
LOCK
3
4 IM1
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
L–W
LOCK
L–W
4 IE1
W–B
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
IE1
W–B
4
3
D16
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
R–G
UNLOCK
IE1
D19
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT LH
W–B
L–R
11
C
A
R–Y
L–Y
L–Y
E
B
Y
L
L–W
R–G
L–W
B
C
A
BP
L4
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
KEY UNLOCK SW
C
LUG
7 A
G–W
A
J 9 A , J10 B
IND
6 B
G–W
B
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
DSWH
3 A
G–W
B
LSWR
16 A
W–B
L–W
F
LSWP
15 A
J 9 A , J10 B
R–G
B
UL2
10 A
+B1
B
L–R
B
L–R
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
11 A
IG
R–Y
L2
8 A
L–Y
UL3
9 A
13 A
+B2
Y
LSWD
HORN
14 A
1 B
T3 B , T4 A
THEFT DETERRENT ECU
L
SH
D B
R
9 B
A B
B–R
G–B
11 IG1
W–L
5 IG3
E A
L–W
J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IK1
2
R
C
C10
THEFT DETERRENT INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
W–L
D10
DIODE
(DOME)
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
4
1
J16 A , J17 B
2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
T1
THEFT
DETERRENT
HORN
R–Y
10 2K
W
3 2F
THEFT DETERRENT (TMC MADE)
SERVICE HINTS
D16, D17 DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SW FRONT LH, RH
1–3 : Closed with door lock cylinder unlocked with key
1–2 : Closed with door lock cylinder locked with key
E6 ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SW
2–1 : Open with engine hood open
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
2–1 : Closed with ignition key in cylinder
L4 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT KEY UNLOCK SW
2–1 : Closed with luggage compartment door lock cylinder unlock
L6 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SW
1–GROUND : Closed with luggage compartment door open
T3 (B), T4 (A) THEFT DETERRENT ECU
(A) 6–GROUND : Continuity with ignition key in cylinder
(A)15–GROUND : Continuity with front RH door unlocked
(A)14–GROUND : Continuity with front LH door unlocked
(A) 5–GROUND : Continuity with front RH door open
(A) 4–GROUND : Continuity with front LH door open
(A) 8–GROUND : Continuity with door key lock and unlock SW to LOCK position
(B) 7–GROUND : Always continuity
(A) 7–GROUND : Continuity with luggage compartment door unlocked
(A) 1–GROUND : Continuity with each door opened
(A) 3–GROUND : Continuity with engine hood close
(A) 2–GROUND : Continuity with luggage compartment door open
(A)16–GROUND : Continuity with rear door unlocked
(A) 9, (A) 10–GROUND : Continuity with door key lock and unlock SW to UNLOCK position
(B) 1, (B) 12, (B) 11, (B) 10, (A) 11–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C10
30
D6
30
D7
30
D10
30
D12
32
D13
32
D14
32
D15
Code
See Page
E6
F4
A
Code
28 (5S–FE)
J33
26 (1MZ–FE)
J34
See Page
A
31
B
31
28 (5S–FE)
J37
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J38
32
28 (5S–FE)
J39
32
J1
31
J40
32
J2
31
L4
32
32
J5
31
L6
32
D16
32
J6
31
D17
32
J9
A
31
D19
32
J10
B
31
T3
B
31
D20
32
31
T4
A
31
D21
32
J16
D22
32
J17
E6
26 (1MZ–FE)
F9
F
J11
J32
27 (1MZ–FE)
T1
29 (5S–FE)
A
31
U1
31
B
31
W6
31
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1B
1C
1D
1G
1J
1M
1S
1V
1W
2F
2J
2K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IE1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG1
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK1
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IM1
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IF1
IF2
IN2
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BO1
44
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
44
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
40
Right Kick Panel
IJ
IK
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
BP
44
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
B6
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor No.2 Wire
THEFT DETERRENT (TMC MADE)
C10
D6
D7
D10
BROWN
GRAY
BLACK
BLACK
1 2
1 2
5
D12
9
D13
D14
X
X X
X X
5 6
X
D15
D16
D19
D17
BLACK
1
1
1
1
1
2
3
1 4
1
2
3
D20
D21
D22
E6
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
1 4
1 4
1 4
F4 (A)
1
J1
F9 (F)
ORANGE
1
J2
J5
BLACK
ORANGE
A A A
CCC
B
B B B B
2
1 2
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J6
B B B B
F F F F
J11
J9 (A)
J10 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
B B C C
A A
D D D E E E
D D D E E E
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J16 (A)
J17 (B)
J32
J33 (A)
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
BLACK
C C
A
A A
E E E
D D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
B
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
B B C C
D D D E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
J34 (B)
J37
J38
J39
A A A
X X
A A A X X X X
A A A
X X
A A A X X X X
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
BLACK
C C
A A B
C C
A A B B B BC C
D D D E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J40
A
A
L4
A
A
A
1 2
L6
T1
GRAY
BLACK
1
1 2
A
T3 (B)
1 X X X X 6
7 X 9 10 11 12
(Hint : See Page 7)
T4 (A)
U1
W6
BLUE
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
X 13 14 15 16 X 18 X X X X
1 2
X X
5 X
THEFT DETERRENT (TMMK MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
1
1
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
5
40A
MAIN
3
2
2
6 1C
1
4
HEAD
RELAY
A
2
3
A
8 2K
G–R
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
4 1B
J 1 (* 1)
J32 (* 2)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
R–B
10 IG1
J33 A
G–R
H
5
R–B
11 B
10 B
18 A
HEAD
T3 B , T4 A
PANI
THEFT DETERRENT ECU
A B
2
R–W
D A
D A
6
D A
R–W
R–W
D7
DIODE
(COURTESY)
1
2
E A
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–W
B–G
1
C A
J9 A
E B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
U1
UNLOCK
WARNING SW
R–Y
L–B
5 1M
1 A
7 B
W–B
B A
E
5 A
R–G
B A
R–G
F4 A , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
7 1D
DSWP
1 A
J 9 A , J10 B
L–B
L–B
2 F
CTY
DSWD
4 A
R–G
KSW
6 A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
DSWL
2 A
R–G
B–R
E A
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF1
3 1M
1 1G
4 1G
D B
4
R–G
IG
1
R–G
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
1
W–B
1
6 IN2
R–W
R–G
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
8 IN2
D13
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT RH
A
12 1S
D14
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR LH
1
INTEGRATION
RELAY
D15
DOOR COURTESY
SW REAR RH
7 1S
R–W
7 1J
W–B
L6
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
BATTERY
R–Y
6
D12
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
B–R
TAIL
100A ALT
LG
7 IG3
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
E3
1 F
W6
WIRELESS DOOR
LOCK ECU
2
H–LP
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
19
(*1)
B
A
R–B
B
A
R
B
(*1)
B–R
G–R
(* 2)
IF
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
7. 5A
DOME
1 1D
8 1D
12 2J
5
HORN
RELAY
2
R
1
15A
ECU–IG
B–R
25A
DOOR
L–W
10A
HORN
1 1W
3
8 1G
G–B
C
G–B
C
B
W–L
C
B
12 B
A
C
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
B
D B
D
A
E A
1 IG3
7 1G
3 1V
20 IM1
A
IE
IJ
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BL
B
B
6 BP1
2
IF1
2
1
1
2
B6
W–B
W–B
W–B
IE1
W–B
20
W–B
W–B
W–B
6 BO1
5
BR
B13
4
E6
ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SW
W–B
B14
IK1
1
D22
DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR RH
4
3
BN
IK
EB
IH
J33 A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
4
4 BP1
L–Y
W–B
1
L–Y
L–Y
4 BO1
9
3 IN2
D21
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW REAR LH
W–B
1
IF2
L–Y
1
2
W–B
3
UNLOCK
2
11 IM1
D20
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT RH
W–B
Y
1
3 IM1
W–B
2
LOCK
3
4 IM1
L
L–W
4 IE1
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
L–W
LOCK
1
IE1
W–B
4
3
D16
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
R–G
UNLOCK
IE1
D19
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT LH
W–B
L–R
11
C
A
R–Y
L–Y
L–Y
E
B
Y
L
L–W
R–G
L–W
B
C
A
BP
L4
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
KEY UNLOCK SW
C
LUG
7 A
G–W
A
J 9 A , J10 B
IND
6 B
G–W
B
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
DSWH
3 A
G–W
B
LSWR
16 A
W–B
L–W
F
LSWP
15 A
J 9 A , J10 B
R–G
B
UL2
10 A
+B1
B
L–R
B
L–R
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
11 A
IG
R–Y
L2
8 A
L–Y
UL3
9 A
13 A
+B2
Y
LSWD
HORN
14 A
1 B
T3 B , T4 A
THEFT DETERRENT ECU
L
SH
D B
R
9 B
A B
B–R
G–B
11 IG1
W–L
5 IG3
E A
L–W
J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IK1
2
R
C
C10
THEFT DETERRENT INDICATOR
LIGHT [COMB. METER]
W–L
D10
DIODE
(DOME)
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
4
1
* 1 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 2 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
J16 A , J17 B
2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
T1
THEFT
DETERRENT
HORN
R–Y
10 2K
W
3 2F
THEFT DETERRENT (TMMK MADE)
SERVICE HINTS
D16, D17 DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SW FRONT LH, RH
1–3 : Closed with door lock cylinder unlocked with key
1–2 : Closed with door lock cylinder locked with key
E6 ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SW
2–1 : Open with engine hood open
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
2–1 : Closed with ignition key in cylinder
L4 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT KEY UNLOCK SW
2–1 : Closed with luggage compartment door lock cylinder unlock
L6 LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT SW
1–GROUND : Closed with luggage compartment door open
T3 (B), T4 (A) THEFT DETERRENT ECU
(A) 6–GROUND : Continuity with ignition key in cylinder
(A)15–GROUND : Continuity with front RH door unlocked
(A)14–GROUND : Continuity with front LH door unlocked
(A) 5–GROUND : Continuity with front RH door open
(A) 4–GROUND : Continuity with front LH door open
(A) 8–GROUND : Continuity with door key lock and unlock SW to LOCK position
(B) 7–GROUND : Always continuity
(A) 7–GROUND : Continuity with luggage compartment door unlocked
(A) 1–GROUND : Continuity with each door opened
(A) 3–GROUND : Continuity with engine hood close
(A) 2–GROUND : Continuity with luggage compartment door open
(A)16–GROUND : Continuity with rear door unlocked
(A) 9, (A) 10–GROUND : Continuity with door key lock and unlock SW to UNLOCK position
(B) 1, (B) 12, (B) 11, (B) 10, (A) 11–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
C10
30
E6
26 (1MZ–FE)
D6
30
E6
28 (5S–FE)
D7
30
D10
30
D12
32
D13
32
D14
32
J1
D15
32
D16
F4
A
Code
J17
See Page
B
J32
31
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J33
A
31
28 (5S–FE)
J34
B
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J37
31
28 (5S–FE)
J40
32
31
L4
32
J2
31
L6
32
32
J5
31
D17
32
J6
31
D19
32
J9
A
31
T3
B
31
D20
32
J10
B
31
T4
A
31
D21
32
D22
32
F9
F
J11
J16
A
27 (1MZ–FE)
T1
29 (5S–FE)
31
U1
31
31
W6
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1B
1C
1D
1G
1J
1M
1S
1V
1W
2F
2J
2K
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IE1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG1
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK1
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IM1
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IF1
IF2
IN2
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BO1
44
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
44
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
40
Right Kick Panel
IJ
IK
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
BP
44
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
B6
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Floor No.2 Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
B13
44
Front Door LH Wire
B14
44
Front Door RH Wire
THEFT DETERRENT (TMMK MADE)
C10
D6
BROWN
5
X 2
9
D7
D10
BLACK
BLACK
1 2
1 2
X X X X X
19 X X
D12
D13
D14
D15
D16
D17
D19
BLACK
1
1
1
1
1
2
3
1 4
1
2
3
D20
D21
D22
E6
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
1 4
1 4
1 4
F4 (A)
1
J1
F9 (F)
ORANGE
1
J2
J5
BLACK
ORANGE
A A A
CCC
B
B B B B
2
1 2
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J6
B B B B
F F F F
J9 (A)
J10 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
J11
B B C C
A A
D D D E E E
D D D E E E
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J16 (A)
J17 (B)
J32
J33 (A)
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
BLACK
C C
A
A
A A
E E E
D D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
B
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
B B C C
D D D E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
J34 (B)
J37
J40
L4
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
C C
A
A
A
A
A
1 2
A
D D D E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
T3 (B)
T4 (A)
U1
1 X X X X 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2
7 X 9 10 11 12
X 13 14 15 16 X 18 X X X X
T1
BLACK
1 2
W6
BLUE
X X
L6
GRAY
BLACK
5 X
1
MOON ROOF
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
1
7. 5A
DOME
30A
POWER
25A
DOOR
10A
GAUGE
2
5
12 2J
R
*
*
*
*
1 : TMC MADE
2 : TMMK MADE
3 : W/O THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
4 : W/ THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
1
POWER
RELAY
3
2
7 1F
7 1J
1 1W
1 1D
J33 A , J34 B
5 1F
R–B
A A
L–W
R
(* 2)
L
W–B
C B
M3
MOON ROOF CONTROL SW
AND RELAY
4
10
13 A (*3)
1 B (*4)
12 A
3 B
7
TILT UP
SLIDE OPEN
6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–W
5 1G
2
8
7
3
5
1
6
8 A (*3)
6 B (*4)
B
INTEGRATION
RELAY
1 A
2 B
J33 A , J34 B
R
5 A
5 B
D B
NO. 1
NO. 2
M
W–B
B2
BM
1
W–B
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
D12
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
(*1)
W–B
IE
W–B
W–B
W–B
3 1V
M4 A , B
MOON ROOF MOTOR
AND LIMIT SW
W–B
3 A (* 1)
3 B (* 2)
4 A
3 1F
R–G
6 IN2
D13
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT RH
B2
NO. 3
R–G
R–G
2 A (*1)
1 B (*2)
E A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–W
4 B
G
R–L
6 A
6 B
(* 2)
P–B
W–B
R–G
7 1S
I18 A ,
1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current is applied at all times through the POWER fuse to TERMINAL 5 of the power relay. With the ignition SW turned on,
the current flows through the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 7 of the integration relay to TERMINAL (A) 12 (w/o theft deterrent
system), (B) 3 (w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 1 of the power relay to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND, as a result, power
relay is activated and the current to TERMINAL 5 of the power relay flows from TERMINAL 3 of the power relay to
TERMINAL 4 of the moon roof control relay.
1. SLIDE OPEN OPERATION
Only when the slide open switch is valid and actuated the moon roof motor continually will operate towards the open
direction of the roof panel.
Releasing and again depressing the open switch, or depressing another operation switch shall cancel this express open
function. The relay shall only operate the moon roof motor continually for approx. 20 seconds per actuation.
2. SLIDE CLOSE OPERATION
Only when the tilt up switch is valid and actuated the moon roof motor will operate towards the close direction of the roof
panel.
When the moon roof reaches about 120 mm short of the fully closed position, the limit switch No.2 is turned from on to off.
Thereby signaling the moon roof control relay to stop the motor. The motor can not continue to operate until the close switch
is released and again depressed.
3. TILT UP OPERATION
Only when the tilt up switch is valid and actuated the moon roof motor will operate towards the closed direction of the roof
panel.
4. TILT DOWN OPERATION
Only when the slide open switch is valid and actuated the moon roof motor will operate towards the open direction of the roof
panel.
5. KEY OFF MOON ROOF OPERATION
With the ignition SW turned from on to off, the integration relay operates and current flows from the DOOR fuse to
TERMINAL (A) 13 (w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 1 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the relay to TERMINAL (A) 12 (w/o theft
deterrent system), (B) 3 (w/ theft deterrent system) to TERMINAL 1 of the power relay to TERMINAL 2 to GROUND for about
43 seconds. In the same way as normal operation, the current flows from the POWER fuse to TERMINAL 5 of the power
relay to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL 4 of the moon roof control relay. As a result, for about 43 seconds after the ignition SW
is turned off, the functioning of this relay makes it possible to open and close the moon roof. Also, by opening the front door
(Door courtesy SW on) within about 43 seconds after turning the ignition SW to off, a signal is input to TERMINALS 6 or (A) 8
(w/o theft deterrent system), (B) 6 (w/ theft deterrent system) of the integration relay. As a result, the relay turns off and open
close movement of the moon roof stops.
SERVICE HINTS
POWER RELAY [INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B]
5–3 : Closed with the ignition SW at ON position or key off moon roof operation
M3 MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AND RELAY
2–GROUND : Always continuity
4–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position or key off moon roof operation
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
I18
See Page
Code
See Page
D12
32
J11
D13
32
J33
A
31
A
30
J34
B
31
B
30
M3
31
33
Code
M4
See Page
A
33
B
33
MOON ROOF
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1D
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1F
20
Roof Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1V
1W
2J
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
IN2
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
BM
44
Roof Left
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
B2
Wire Harness with Splice Points
44
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Roof Wire
D12
D13
I18 (A)
I18 (B)
(w/o Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
1
8 1213
1
(w/ Theft Deterrent System) ORANGE
1 X 3 X 6
X X
X X X X X X X
J11
A
A
J33 (A)
J34 (B)
M3
M3
BLACK
BLACK
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
12
3
45X7X
12
3
456 7 8
A
A
A
A
A A
C C
E E E
D D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
M4 (A)
M4 (B)
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
1 2
1 2
3 4
3 4
5 6
5 6
MEMO
POWER SEAT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
1
30A
POWER
2
L–W
3 1D
L–W
A A A A
L–W
J 9 A , J10 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IF1
L–W
C B
L–W
8
L–W
2 BQ1
P14 A , B
11 A (*1)
2 B (*2)
M
BL
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
1
5
P19
POWER SEAT MOTORS (DRIVER’ S SEAT)
2
P16
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(DRIVER’ S SEAT
REAR VERTICAL
CONTROL)
6
1
4
(*2)
R
R
M
(*1)
(*1)
1
P17
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(DRIVER’ S SEAT
RECLINING CONTROL)
2
(*2)
L–Y
(*2)
R–B
(*1)
R–B
(*1)
M
3 A (* 1)
8 B (* 2)
2 A
5 B
W–B
3
(*2)
2
P18
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(DRIVER’ S SEAT
SLIDE CONTROL)
1 BQ1
R–G
(*2)
R–G
(*1)
2
REAR VERTICAL
5 A
6 B
1 A
12 B
L–B
L–B
(*1)
L
L
(*2)
W–B
4 A
7 B
1
DOWN
RECLINING
8 A
11 B
L–Y
SLIDE
7 A
4 B
UP
REAR
FRONT
REAR
FRONT
POWER SEAT CONTROL SW (DRIVER’ S SEAT)
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMMK MADE
L–W
L–W
4 IN2
L–W
2 BR1
P15 A , B
11 A (*1)
2 B (*2)
SLIDE
4 A
7 B
DOWN
UP
RECLINING
1 A
12 B
REAR VERTICAL
5 A
6 B
3 A
8 B
7 A (* 1)
4 B (* 2)
2 A
5 B
M
1
2
P20
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(FRONT PASSENGER’ S SEAT
REAR VERTICAL
CONTROL)
6
1
(*2)
R
R
(*1)
(*1)
M
4
B6
W–B
5
L–Y
1
P21
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(FRONT PASSENGER’ S SEAT
RECLINING CONTROL)
2
(*2)
L–Y
(*2)
(*1)
R–B
R–B
(*1)
(*2)
2
P22
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(FRONT PASSENGER’ S SEAT
SLIDE CONTROL)
3
R–G
(*2)
R–G
L–B
2
P23
POWER SEAT MOTORS (FRONT PASSENGER’ S SEAT)
IK
W–B
M
1 BR1
W–B
1
(*1)
L–B
(*1)
L
L
(*2)
W–B
8 A
11 B
REAR
FRONT
REAR
FRONT
POWER SEAT CONTROL SW (FRONT PASSENGER’ S SEAT)
BN
POWER SEAT
SERVICE HINTS
P14 (A), (B) POWER SEAT CONTROL SW (DRIVER’S SEAT)
(A) 11, (B) 2–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 7, (B) 4–GROUND : Always continuity
P15 (A), (B) POWER SEAT CONTROL SW (FRONT PASSENGER’S SEAT)
(A) 11, (B) 2–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 7, (B) 4–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
J9
A
31
J10
B
31
P15
See Page
Code
See Page
A
34
P19
34
B
34
P20
34
32
P16
34
P21
34
A
34
P17
34
P22
34
B
34
P18
34
P23
34
J40
P14
Code
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1D
See Page
20
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IF1
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IN2
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BQ1
46
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Driver’s Seat)
BR1
46
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Passenger’s Seat)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IK
40
Right Kick Panel
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
B6
See Page
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor No.2 Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
J9 (A)
J10 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
J40
A
A A
C C
P14 (A)
(TMC Made) BLACK
A
A
A
A
1 2 3
4 5
X 7 8 X X 11 X
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
P14 (B)
(TMMK Made) BLACK
P15 (A)
P15 (B)
(TMC Made) BLACK
X 2 X
4 5
6 7 8 X X 1112
1 2 3
4 5
X 7 8 X X 11 X
P16
P17
1 2
1 2
(TMMK Made) BLACK
X 2 X
4 5
6 7 8 X X 1112
P18
P19
P20
P21
P22
P23
1 2
1 2 3
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2 3
4 5 6
4 5 6
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
15A
EFI
5A
IGN
5A
STARTER
7 1C
3 1J
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
E5
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
BR
3
I2
BR
2
2
B–R
5
EFI RELAY
1
B–W
W
7 1W
15A
STOP
4 2F
2 2J
G–W
5 2C
8 2J
7 2K
T2
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
1
B–W
B–Y
W–B
W–B
4 1R
2
1
1
3
2
BR
9 E
19 E
20 E
W–L
SLN+
2
6
3
2
4
1
S2
S1
SL
SLN–
SLN+
W–B
W–B
EB
THW
NC2–
26 E
R
J26
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
V
14 E
1
G
C15
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
NC2+
E3
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
V3
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION)
ECT
R
6
L
OD
Y
14
A
W
IDL
A
L–B
13
A
L–B
14 D
E2
G
SL
7 E
B
L–B
7
II2
G–B
L
S1
8 E
B–Y
Y–B
S2
P–L
24 B
18 D
VC
SLN–
NSW
L–B
4 B
L–R
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
23 D
Y
J27 A , J28 B
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 D
20 B
VTA1
15 A
B–W
G–W
2 A
STP
B–R
1 A
BATT
B
E 7 A , E 8 B , E10 D , E11 E
OD1
IDLO
MREL
B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J35
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8 A
+B
C B
IGSW
16 A
C
A A
B–Y
B–Y
B B
C
B–W
B A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J27 A , J28 B
G–W
5 1R
(1MZ–FE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
R–L
* 1 : CALIFORNIA
* 2 : EXCEPT CALIFORNIA
* 3 : TMMK MADE
* 4 : TMC MADE
10A
GAUGE
J28 B
1 1J
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
B
R–L
F
B
R–L
2 1D
R–L
2
II2
D
D
R–L
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
Y
L–W
(* 4)
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
O
(* 3)
A
A
A
R–L
A
B
R–B
C
A
R–B
C
A
R–B
3
IG3
V–W
R–L
V–W
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
V–W
R–B
22 B
R
O
(*3)
(*4)
2 B
Y
3 B
2
L–W
J27 A , J28 B
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
14 B
7 C
O/D OFF
SPEEDOMETER
R–L
C
IJ1
C
O2
O/D MAIN
SW
2
A
B
A
4
BR
BR
BR
(* 2)
BR
A
BR
BR
(*1)
J26
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–O
C
2
G–O
IJ1
12 A
G–O
3
7
BR
G–O
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
SI
5 C
P
G–O
SE
2
11 IG3
6 C
P
BR
15 B
V2
VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION
METER)
L
10 B
1
IG+
L
31 E
COMBINATION METER
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
E02
21 E
BR
E01
30 E
BR
OD2
17 D
BR
E1
E03
L
SPD
E 7 A , E 8 B , E10 D , E11 E
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
12 B
BR
(*1)
ED
EC
IH
W–B
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
R–L
R–L
2
P1
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
* 3 : TMMK MADE
* 4 : TMC MADE
C
DL
NL
RL
PL
3
10
9
8
7
D
A
D
A
D
(*4)
O
R–B
IJ1
3
II3
4
R
R–B
1
II2
G–W
R
B–R
II2
B–R
(* 3)
O
9
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
L–W
II2
L–W
E
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
Y
6
(* 4)
Y
II2
Y
5
G–W
2L
4
L–W
LL
(*3)
R–B
14 IG3
10 1H
G–W
B–R
O
5 1V
(* 3)
Y
(* 4)
R–B
L–W
R–B
R–B
8 A
16 B
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
W–B
COMBINATION METER
A
W–B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
W–B
W–B
IF
9 A
P
R
10 A
R
B–R
7 A
N
O
11 A
D
Y
6 A
2
L
13 IG3
G–W
15 IG3
16 IG3
(1MZ–FE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Previous automatic transaxle have selected each gear shift using the mechanically controlled throttle hydraulic pressure,
governor hydraulic pressure and lock–up hydraulic pressure. The electronically controlled transmission, however, electrically
controls the line pressure and lock–up pressure etc., through the solenoid valve. Engine control module control of the
solenoid valve based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift selection for each gear
which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the engine control module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions,
based on input signals from the engine coolant temp. sensor to TERMINAL THW of the engine control module, and also the
input signals to TERMINAL NC2+ of the engine control module from the vehicle speed sensor devoted to the O/D direct
clutch. Current is then output to the electronically controlled transmission solenoid. When shifting to 1st speed, current flows
from TERMINAL S1 of the engine control module to TERMINAL 3 of the electronically controlled transmission solenoid to
GROUND, and continuity to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For the 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the engine control module to TERMINAL 3 of the electronically
controlled transmission solenoid to GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the engine control module to TERMINAL 6 of the
electronically controlled transmission solenoid to GROUND, and continuity to solenoids No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For the 3rd speed, there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2, causing the shift.
Shifting into 4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 solenoid.
2. LOCK–UP OPERATION
When the engine control module judges from each signal that lock–up operation conditions have been met, current flows
from TERMINAL SL of the engine control module to TERMINAL 2 of the electronically controlled transmission solenoid to
GROUND, causing continuity to the lock–up solenoid and causing lock–up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop light SW on) when driving in lock–up condition, a signal is input to TERMINAL STP of
the engine control module, the engine control module operates and continuity to the lock–up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
∗ Overdrive on
When the O/D main SW is turned on (O/D off indicator light turns off), a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the engine
control module and engine control module operation causes gear shift when the conditions for overdrive are met.
∗ Overdrive off
When the O/D main SW is turned to off (O/D off indicator light turns on), the current flowing through the O/D off indicator
light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND. Causing the indicator light to light up. At the same time, a signal is
input to TERMINAL OD2 of the engine control module and engine control module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
SERVICE HINTS
E7 (A), E8 (B), E10 (D), E11 (E) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (TURN ON THE IGNITION SW)
S1, S2–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the solenoid on
0–1.5 volts with the solenoid off
L–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at L position
2–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at 2 position
R–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at R position
STP–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the brake pedal depressed
THW–E2 : 0.2–1.0 volts with the engine coolant temp. 80°C (176°F)
VAT1–E2 : 0.3–0.8 volts with the throttle valve fully closed
3.2–4.9 volts with the throttle valve fully opened
VC–E2 : 4.5–5.5 volts
OD2–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the O/D main SW turned off
0–3.0 volts with the O/D main SW turned on
+B–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts
OD1–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts
E3 ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
2, 3, 6–GROUND : Each 11–15 Ω
O2 O/D MAIN SW
2–4 : Closed with the O/D main SW off, open with the O/D main SW on
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
C8
See Page
Code
E11
See Page
E
Code
30
J28
See Page
A
30
B
31
C9
B
30
J4
31
J29
31
C10
C
30
J5
31
J35
31
C15
30
J6
31
O2
31
E3
26 (1MZ–FE)
J15
31
P1
27 (1MZ–FE)
E5
26 (1MZ–FE)
J22
31
S6
31
E7
A
30
J24
31
T2
27 (1MZ–FE)
E8
B
30
J26
31
V2
27 (1MZ–FE)
E10
D
30
31
V3
27 (1MZ–FE)
J27
A
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1C
1D
1H
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2
No 2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1R
1V
1W
2C
2F
2J
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IG3
II2
II3
IJ1
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
36 (1MZ–FE)
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
36 (1MZ–FE)
Surge Tank RH
ED
36 (1MZ–FE)
Rear Side of the Surge Tank
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I2
See Page
42
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
(1MZ–FE)
C8 (A)
C8 (A)
(TMC Made) BLUE
6
(TMMK Made) BLUE
7 8 9 10 11 12
6
C9 (B)
C9 (B)
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
14 15 16
C10 (C)
5 6
14 15 16
C10 (C)
7
E3
E5
GRAY
DARK GRAY
C15
(TMMK Made) BROWN
(TMC Made) BROWN
5 6
X 6
7
E7 (A)
13 14
E8 (B)
1 2
1 2 3
4 X 6
2
7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 X X
X 2 3 4 X X
8 X X 15
10 X 12 X X X X
16
20 X 22
X
X 24 X X
E10 (D)
E10 (D)
E11 (E)
(California)
(Except California) BLACK
(California)
X 2
X
X 7 8 9
14 X
X 14 X
14 19 20 21
17 18
17 18 X X
X 26
23
23
30 31
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
(1MZ–FE)
E11 (E)
J4
J5
(Except California) BLACK
BLACK
ORANGE
X X
DD DX
X 7 8 9
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
14 19 20 21
X 26
(Hint : See Page 7)
30 31
J15
J6
J22
J24
BLACK
B B
B
CC C
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
A
A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J26
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
J29
A
B
A A B B B
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
A A A A A
B B B B
DD DE E E
F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
O2
P1
S6
T2
BLUE
GRAY
BLUE
BLACK
J35
2
4
C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
V2
V3
BLACK
BLACK
1 2 3
1
2
X
7
2
8
3 4
9 10
1 2 3
1
2
MEMO
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
15A
EFI
5A
IGN
7 1C
5
3 1J
W–B
W–B
B–Y
B–W
B
2
1
2
1 B
1 B
10 B
11 B
9 B
9 B
SL
15 C
15 C
24 C (*1)
14 C (*2)
P
A
V
A
1 B
3 B
1 A
S2
S1
SL
A
6
BR
L–B
20 C
1 C
W
ECT
A
A
A
BR
W–B
NO. 2
C15
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
LOCK–UP
OD
J25
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
NO. 1
II2
8 C
7 C
L–B
Y–B
14
7
L–B
L–R
13
S1
BR
S2
21 C
6 C
18 A
20 A
E2
E04
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
L–B
IDL
VC
E3 A , E4 B
EB
THW
NSW
4 B (* 1)
4 B (* 2)
E1
22 A
22 A
VTA
9 A
4 A
B
3 A
3 A
BATT
1 A
(CALIFORNIA)
MREL
OD1
IDLO
+B
2 A
1 A
J23
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 D
STP
12 A
12 A
IGSW
G–W
BR
3
LG
1
Y
T2
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
J27 A , J28 B
(*1)
B–Y
C B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A A
B–W
5 1R
G–W
(*1)
B–Y
B–R
(* 1)
4 1R
II4
B–W
B B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B A
6
8 2J
BR
7 2K
G–W
2 2J
J27 A , J28 B
4 2F
E5
ENGINE COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
BR
B
1
5 2C
G–B
2
I2
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
B–W
(* 2)
B–R
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
2
EFI
RELAY
1
5A
STARTER
W
7 1W
15A
STOP
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
EC
BR
(5S–FE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
* 1 : W/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 2 : W/O ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
* 3 : TMC MADE
* 4 : TMMK MADE
R–L
10A
GAUGE
1 1J
2 1D
R–L
J28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
B
R–L
D
D
R–L
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
B
Y
L–W
(* 3)
O
R–L
(* 4)
R–B
O
(* 4)
(* 3)
L–W
Y
R–B
2
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B V–W
II2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
7 C
O/D OFF
6 C
L
L
IJ1
11 IG3
5 C
2
IJ1
3
2
SI
SE
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
V2
VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION
METER)
BR
IG+
R–L
C
C
C
G–O
BR
BR
BR
BR
1
EC
12 A
G–O
15 B
P
A
7
G–O
V–W
COMBINATION METER
G–O
BR
BR
BR
14 B
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
R–L
BR
A
P
OD2
5 A (* 1)
7 A (* 2)
R–B
A
R–L
26 C
26 C
C
A
SPEEDOMETER
R
13 C
13 C
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D
2
SPD
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
L
25 C
16 B
8 A (* 1)
9 A (* 2)
E02
17 A
17 A
E01
16 A
18 A
E03
15 A
19 A
R–B
J27 A , J28 B
3
IG3
R–L
V–W
A
B
C
A
IH
G–O
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
R–L
R–L
2
* 3 : TMC MADE
* 4 : TMMK MADE
P1
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
C
DL
NL
RL
PL
3
10
9
8
7
L–W
D
A
D
A
D
(* 3)
O
R–B
3
R
IJ1
II3
4
R–B
1
II2
G–W
R
B–R
II2
B–R
(* 4)
O
9
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
L–W
II2
L–W
E
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
Y
6
(* 3)
Y
II2
Y
5
G–W
2L
4
L–W
LL
B–R
G–W
Y
5 1V
14 IG3
10 1H
15 IG3
G–W
8 A
9 A
2
16 B
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
W–B
COMBINATION METER
A
2
4
O2
O/D MAIN
SW
W–B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
W–B
G–O
IF
P
R–B
10 A
R
R
7 A
N
B–R
11 A
D
6 A
L
O
13 IG3
Y
16 IG3
O
R–B
(*4)
R–B
L–W
R–B
(*3)
(* 4)
R–B
(5S–FE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Previous automatic transaxle have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled throttle hydraulic pressure,
governor hydraulic pressure and lock–up hydraulic pressure. The electronically controlled transmission, however, electrically
controls the line pressure and lock–up pressure etc., through the solenoid valve. Engine control module controls of the
solenoid valve based on the input signals from each sensor which makes smooth driving possible by shift selection for each
gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the engine control module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions,
based on input signals from the engine coolant temp. sensor to TERMINAL THW of the engine control module, and also the
input signals to TERMINAL SPD of the engine control module from the vehicle speed sensor devoted to the electronically
controlled transmission. Current is then output to the electronically controlled transmission solenoid. When shifting to 1st
speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the engine control module to TERMINAL (B) 3 of the solenoid to GROUND, and
continuity to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the engine control module to TERMINAL (B) 3 of the solenoid to
GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the engine control module to TERMINAL (B) 1 of the solenoid to GROUND, and
continuity to solenoids No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed, there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2, causing the shift.
Shifting into 4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 solenoid.
2. LOCK–UP OPERATION
When the engine control module judges from each signal that lock–up operation conditions have been met, current flows
from TERMINAL SL of the engine control module to TERMINAL (A) 1 of the electronically controlled transmission solenoid to
GROUND, causing continuity to the lock–up solenoid and causing lock–up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop light SW on) when driving in lock–up condition, a signal is input to TERMINAL STP of
the engine control module, the engine control module operates and continuity to the lock–up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
∗ O/D main SW on
When the O/D main SW is turned on (O/D off indicator light turns off), a signal is input into TERMINAL OD2 of the engine
control module and engine control module operation causes gear shift when the conditions for overdrive are met.
∗ O/D main SW off
When the O/D main SW is turned to off, the current through the O/D off indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to
GROUND, causing the indicator light to light up. At the same time, a signal is input into TERMINAL OD2 of the engine
control module and engine control module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
SERVICE HINTS
E7 (A), E8 (B), E9 (C) ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (TURN ON THE IGNITION SW)
S1, S2–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the solenoid on
0–1.5 volts with the solenoid off
L–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at L position
2–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at 2 position
R–E1 : 7.5–14.0 volts with the shift lever at R position
STP–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the brake pedal depressed
THW–E2 : 0.2–1.0 volts with the engine coolant temp. 60°C (140°F) – 120°C (248°F)
VTA–E2 : 0.3–0.8 volts with the throttle valve fully closed
3.2–4.9 volts with the throttle valve fully opened
VC–E2 : 4.5–5.5 volts
OD2–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts with the O/D main SW turned on
0–3.0 volts with the O/D main SW turned off
+B–E1 : 9.0–14.0 volts
E3 (A), E4 (B) ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
(A) 1, (B) 1, (B) 3–GROUND : Each 11–15 Ω
O2 O/D MAIN SW
2–4 : Closed with the O/D main SW off, open with the O/D main SW on
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
C8
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
30
E9
C9
B
30
E10
C10
C
30
J4
31
J29
31
30
J5
31
O2
31
C15
C
30
J27
D
30
J28
See Page
A
A
31
B
31
E3
A
28 (5S–FE)
J6
31
P1
29 (5S–FE)
E4
B
28 (5S–FE)
J15
31
S6
31
28 (5S–FE)
J21
31
T2
29 (5S–FE)
E7
E5
A
30
J23
31
V2
29 (5S–FE)
E8
B
30
J25
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1C
1D
1H
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2
No 2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1R
1V
1W
2C
2F
2J
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IG3
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
42
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
II2
II3
II4
IJ1
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
38 (5S–FE)
Left Radiator Side Support
EC
38 (5S–FE)
Intake Manifold
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I2
See Page
42
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
(5S–FE)
∗ 1 : w/ Engine Immobiliser System
∗ 2 : w/o Engine Immobiliser System
C8 (A)
C8 (A)
(TMC Made) BLUE
6
(TMMK Made) BLUE
7 8 9 10 11 12
6
7 8 9 10 11 12
C9 (B)
C9 (B)
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
14 15 16
C10 (C)
C15
C10 (C)
(TMC Made) BROWN
5 6
14 15 16
(TMMK Made) BROWN
7
5 6
7
E3 (A)
E4 (B)
E5
E7 (A)
BLACK
BLACK
GREEN
(∗ 1)
1 2
1 2 3 5 8 9
1 X 3
1
X
X 6
13 14
12 15 16 17 18 22
E7 (A)
E8 (B)
E8 (B)
E9 (C)
(∗ 2)
(∗ 1) DARK GRAY
(∗ 2)
(∗ 1) DARK GRAY
1 3 4 X 7 9
1 4
1 4
X 8 13
12 17 18 19 20 22
9 10
9 11 16
15 X X 20 21 24 25 26
E9 (C)
E10 (D)
J4
J5
(∗ 2)
(∗ 1) DARK GRAY
BLACK
ORANGE
1 6 7 13
X
14 15 X 26
7 X
X X
DD DX
(Hint : See Page 7)
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION AND A/T INDICATOR
(5S–FE)
J6
J15
J21
BLACK
GRAY
B B
B
CC C
J23
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
A A A
A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J25
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
J29
A
A A
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
A A A A A
B B B B
D D DE E E
F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
O2
P1
S6
T2
V2
BLUE
GRAY
BLUE
BLACK
BLACK
1 2 3
1 2 3
2
4
X
7
2
8
3 4
9 10
1
2
MEMO
CRUISE CONTROL
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
R–L
R–L
(* 1)
10A
GAUGE
(* 1 A/T)
A
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
R–L
R–L
(* 2)
(* 2 A/T)
D A
2
2
D
10
B–R
(*1)
R–L
(*2)
R–L
R–L
(M/T)
1
II2
B–R
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
(A/T)
B–R
(M/T)
R–L
9
(A/T)
D
J27 A , J28 B
F B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F B
D
P1
D POSITION SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
II2
C14
CRUISE CONTROL
CLUTCH SW
2
R–L
R–L
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 1J
R–L
A
2 1D
C 9 B , C10 C
COMBINATION METER
A
C15
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
CRUISE
BR
V–W
O
TC
SPD
CMS
CCS
5
12
11
10
3 IG3
5 IG2
D
P
D
D
2
B
4
CMS
CCS
RESUME/
ACCEL
IG+
TC
V–W
(*3)
SET/
COAST
P–B
4
A/D
11
TC
CANCEL
EP
BR
3
(* 1)
R–L
(* 2)
B
5
II3
LG–R
LG–R
10
11
1
R–L
B
SE
O
SI
B
B
(*4)
L
3
V2
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION METER)
V–W
O
LG–R
IJ1
J2
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
2
O
IJ1
LG–R
4
W
P
PI
W–L
10 C
CRUISE
14 B
V–W
5 C
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
6 C
L
D
15 B
7
3
J3
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
SPEEDOMETER
B–R
7 C
D4
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
C12
CRUISE CONTROL
SW [COMB. SW]
W–B
IH
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
E3 A , E4 B
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E11 E
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
S2
S2
8 E (* 1)
21 C (* 5)
6 C (* 6)
6 A (* 1)
1 B (* 2)
7 1C
J26 (* 1) ,
J25 (* 2)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
W
L–B
9 1J
(A/T)
Y–B
(A/T)
L–R
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
* 3 : TMMK MADE 1MZ–FE
* 4 : EXCEPT *3
* 5 : 5S–FE W/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER
* 6 : 5S–FE W/O ENGINE IMMOBILISER
15A
STOP
B–R
24 B
18 A
20 A
L–B
4 B
3 A
3 A
OD1
15A
ECU–IG
(A/T)
IDLO
ELECTRONICALLY
CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION
SOLENOID
L–B
(A/T)
A
C
7
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
II2
6
9
OD
IDL
ECT
GND
B
MO
15
MC
L
7
W–B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
4
W–B
8 1J
1
2
2
A
A
R–Y
W–B
A A
W
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
J8 B
R–B
J7 A ,
R–G
A B
A A
2
G–W
3
A A
STP–
8
G–B
16
1
G–W
C15
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
14
G–W
13
B–R
L–B
(A/T)
C
3
W–B
7 1J
A
W–B
IG
J11
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
5 1R
M
4 1R
C3
CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
W–B
4
J27 A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
CRUISE CONTROL
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current is applied at all times through the STOP fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the stop light SW.
With the ignition SW turned to on, current flows through the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL (C) 7 of the combination meter and
the current through the ECU–IG fuse flows to TERMINAL 9 of the cruise control ECU.
When the ignition SW is on and the cruise control SW is turned on, a signal is input from TERMINAL 5 of the cruise control
SW to TERMINAL 11 of the cruise control ECU. As a result, the cruise control ECU functions and the current flows from the
ECU–IG fuse to TERMINAL 9 of the cruise control ECU to TERMINAL 16 to GROUND, and the cruise control system is in a
condition ready for operation.
At the same time, the current through the GAUGE fuse flows to TERMINAL (C) 7 of the cruise control indicator light to
TERMINAL (C) 10 to TERMINAL 4 of the cruise control ECU to TERMINAL 16 to GROUND, causing the cruise control
indicator light to light up, indicating that cruise control is ready for operation.
1. SET OPERATION
When the cruise control SW is turned on and the set SW is pushed with the vehicle speed within the set limit (Approx. 40
km/h, 25 mph to 200 km/h, 124 mph), a signal is input to TERMINAL 10 of the cruise control ECU and the vehicle speed at
the time the set SW is released is memorized in the ECU as the set speed.
2. SET SPEED CONTROL
During cruise control driving, the cruise control ECU compares the set speed memorized in the cruise control ECU with the
actual vehicle speed input into TERMINAL 12 of the cruise control ECU from the speed sensor, and controls the cruise
control actuator to maintain the set speed.
When the actual speed is lower than the set speed, the ECU causes the current to the cruise control actuator to flow from
TERMINAL 15 of the cruise control ECU to TERMINAL 1 of the cruise control actuator to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 7 of
the cruise control ECU. As a result, the motor in the cruise control actuator is rotated to open the than the set speed, the
current to the cruise control actuator flows from TERMINAL 7 of the cruise control ECU to TERMINAL 2 of the cruise control
actuator to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 15 of the cruise control ECU.
This causes the motor in the cruise control actuator to rotate to close the throttle valve and return the throttle cable to
decrease the vehicle speed.
3. COAST CONTROL
During cruise control driving, while the coast SW is on, the cruise control actuator returns the throttle cable to close the
throttle valve and decrease the driving speed. The vehicle speed when the coast SW is turned off is memorized and the
vehicle continues at the new set speed.
4. ACCEL CONTROL
During cruise control driving, while the accel SW is turned on, the cruise control actuator pulls the throttle cable to open the
throttle valve and increase the driving speed.
The vehicle speed when the accel SW is turned off is memorized and the vehicle continues at the new set speed.
5. RESUME CONTROL
Unless the vehicle speed falls below the minimum speed limit (Approx. 40km/h, 25mph) after canceling the set speed by the
cancel SW, pushing the resume SW will cause the vehicle to resume the speed set before cancellation.
6. MANUAL CANCEL MECHANISM
If any of the following operations occurs during cruise control operation, the magnetic clutch of the actuator turns off and the
motor rotates to close the throttle valve and the cruise control is released.
∗ Placing the shift lever except D position (Park/Neutral position SW except D position). ”Signal is not input to TERMINAL 3
of the cruise control ECU” (A/T)
∗ Depressing the clutch pedal (Cruise control clutch SW off). ”Signal input to TERMINAL 3 of the cruise control ECU” (M/T)
∗ Depressing the brake pedal (Stop light SW on). ”Signal input to TERMINAL 2 of the cruise control ECU”
∗ Pushing the cancel switch (Cancel SW on). ”Signal input to TERMINAL 10 of the cruise control ECU”
∗ Pushing the cruise switch off ”signal input to TERMINAL 11 of the cruise control ECU”.
7. TAP–UP CONTROL FUNCTION
When the difference between the actual vehicle speed and the set speed is less than 5 km/h (3 mph), the set speed can be
increased 1.6 km/h (1 mph) each time by operation the RESUME/ACCEL SW quickly within 0.6 seconds.
8. TAP–DOWN CONTROL FUNCTION
When the difference between the actual vehicle speed and the set speed is less than 5 km/h (3 mph), the set speed can be
lowered 1.6 km/h (1 mph) each time by operating the SET/COAST SW quickly within 0.6 seconds.
9. AUTO CANCEL FUNCTION
A) If any of the following operating conditions occurs during cruise control operation, the set speed is erased, the current
flow to the magnetic clutch is stopped and the cruise control is released. (Cruise SW turns off).
When this occurs, the ignition SW must be turned off once before the cruise SW will turn on.
∗ When current continued to flow to the motor inside the actuator in the throttle valve ”OPEN” direction.
∗ The motor does not operate despite the motor drive signal being output.
B) If any of the following operating conditions occurs during cruise control operation, the set speed is erased, the current
flow to the magnetic clutch is stopped and the cruise control is released. (Cruise SW turn off).
When this occurs, the cancel state is cleared as the cruise SW will turn on again.
∗ Over current to transistor driving the motor and/or the magnetic clutch.
∗ Open circuit in the magnetic clutch.
∗ Momentary interruption of vehicle speed signal.
∗ Short circuit in the cruise control SW.
∗ When the vehicle speed falls more than 16 km/h (10 mph) below the set speed, E.G. on an upward slope.
C) If any of the following conditions occurs during cruise control operation, the set speed is erased and the cruise control is
released. (The power to the magnetic clutch is cut off until the set SW is ON again.)
∗ When the vehicle speed falls below the minimum speed limit, approx. 40 km/h (25 mph).
∗ When power to the cruise control system is momentarily cut off.
D) If any of the following conditions occurs during cruise control operation, the cruise control is released.
∗ Open the circuit for TERMINAL 2 of the stop light SW.
10. AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE CONTROL FUNCTION
∗ In overdrive. If the vehicle speed becomes lower than the overdrive cut speed (Set speed minus approx. 4 km/h, 2.5 mph)
during cruise control operation, such as driving up a hill, the overdrive is released and the power increased to prevent a
reduction in vehicle speed.
∗ After releasing the overdrive, vehicle speed becomes higher than the overdrive return speed (Set speed minus approx. 2
km/h, 1.2 mph) and the cruise control ECU judges by the signals from the actuator’s potentiometer that the upward slope
has finished, the overdrive is resumed after approximately 2 seconds.
∗ During cruise control driving, the cruise control operation signal is output from the cruise control ECU to the engine control
module. Upon receiving this signal, the engine control module changes the shift pattern to normal.
To maintain smooth cruise control operation (on a downward slope etc.), the lock–up release of the transmission when the
idling point of the throttle position is ON is forbidden.
SERVICE HINTS
C3 CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
3–4 : Approx. 38.5 Ω
C12 CRUISE CONTROL SW [COMB. SW]
5–3 : Continuity with the CRUISE SW on
4–3 : Approx. 418 Ω with the CANCEL SW on
Approx. 68 Ω with the RESUME/ACCEL SW on
Approx. 198 Ω with the SET/COAST SW on
C15 CRUISE CONTROL ECU
9–GROUND : 10–14 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
12–GROUND : 4 pulses with 1 rotation of rotor shaft
10–GROUND : Approx. 418 Ω with the CANCEL SW on in the cruise control SW
Approx. 198 Ω with the SET/COAST SW on in the cruise control SW
Approx. 68 Ω with the RESUME/ACCEL SW on in the cruise control SW
16–GROUND : Always continuity
CRUISE CONTROL
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C3
Code
26 (1MZ–FE)
E7
See Page
Code
See Page
A
30
J21
31
28 (5S–FE)
E8
B
30
J24
31
C9
B
30
E9
C
30
J25
31
C10
C
30
E11
E
30
J26
31
C12
30
J2
31
J27
A
31
C14
30
J3
31
J28
B
31
C15
30
D1
D4
J4
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J7
A
31
28 (5S–FE)
J8
B
31
30
J11
31
E3
A
26 (1MZ–FE)
J12
31
E4
B
28 (1S–FE)
J15
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
1R
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IG2
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
II2
II3
IJ1
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
J29
P1
S6
V2
31
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
31
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
∗ 1 : 5S–FE w/ Engine Immobiliser System
∗ 2 : 5S–FE w/o Engine Immobiliser System
C3
C9 (B)
BLACK
(TMC Made)
1 2 3 4
C9 (B)
(TMMK Made)
14 15
14 15
C10 (C)
C10 (C)
C12
(TMC Made) BROWN
(TMMK Made) BROWN
BLACK
5 6
7 10
C14
5 6
C15
7 10
XX3 4 5
D1
D1
(1MZ–FE) BLACK
(5S–FE) BLACK
X X
X 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2
X X
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
X
X X
X X
X
X
X
X 11
X
X
X
X
X X
X
X X
X
X
X
X 11
X
X
X
D4
E3 (A)
E4 (B)
E7 (A)
DARK GRAY
GRAY
BLACK
(∗ 1)
1 X
3
X
X 6
X
18
X X X 10 X X X
X X 4 X X
E7 (A)
E8 (B)
E9 (C)
(∗ 2)
(1MZ–FE)
(∗ 1) DARK GRAY
3 X
20
X
X 4 X X
X
X X X X X
X
X 24 X X
X X 21
X
CRUISE CONTROL
E9 (C)
E11 (E)
(5S–FE w/o Engine Immobiliser System)
E11 (E)
(1MZ–FE Except California) BLACK
(1MZ–FE California)
6
X
J2
X 8
X
X
J3
J4
J7 (A)
BLACK
GRAY
X X
DD DX
B
B B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
X 8
BLACK
DDD
A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J8 (B)
J11
GRAY
A
A A A A A A
A
A
A
A
J12
J15
BLACK
BLACK
CCC
B B
B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J21
J24
J25
J26
A A A
A A A
A
A A
A
A A
A
A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
GRAY
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
J29
A A
A A A A A
D D
F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
X
(Hint : See Page 7)
P1
S6
V2
GRAY
BLUE
BLACK
2
10
1
3
2
4
1 2 3
MEMO
ABS AND TRACTION CONTROL
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
1
3
60A
FL ABS
3
2
ABS
MOTOR
RELAY
1
W–R
3
GR–R
2
4
GR–L
3
3
1
5
4
GR–R
2
ABS
SOL
RELAY
3
3
3
GR–L
3
6
GR–R
3
R–L
R–L
GR
1 A
24 A
R+
GND3
MR
GND2
9 C
10 C
W–B
SR
11 A
W–B
W–L
W–B
A15 A , A16 B , A17 C
ABS AND TRACTION ECU
SFRH
13 A
SFRR
26 A
W–R
R–B
W–R
GR
9 A
SFRH
3 A
SFRR
4 BS
B
W–L
A7 A , A8 B
W–B
ABS AND TRACTION
ACTUATOR
W–B
E1
EA
W–R
W–B
E1
W–B
E1
W–B
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
9 1J
7 1C
W
15A
STOP
B–R
15A
ECU–IG
C
G–W
2
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A A
5 1R
J27 A , J28 B
S6
STOP
LIGHT SW
C
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C B
4 1R
G–W
1
B–R
G–W
R–L
R–L
A15 A , A16 B , A17 C
ABS AND TRACTION ECU
8 B
16 B
STP
12 A
SFLH
6 A
SFLR
5 A
SRRR
10 A
SRLH
4 A
SRLR
7 A
SRC1
2 A
SRC2
8 A
SMC1
1 A
SMC2
AST
MT
10 A
14 A
5 B
AST
GND1
15 A
W–B
R–W
SMC2
6 C
Y–B
SMC1
12 C
Y–R
SRC2
4 C
B–Y
SRC1
5 C
B–R
SRLR
12 A
LG–B
R–G
11 A
SRRH
SRLH
25 A
G–Y
SRRR
7 C
W–R
SRRH
8 C
W–L
SFLR
1 C
L–B
SFLH
2 C
R
IG1
3 B
MT
M
BM
2 B
A7 A , A8 B
GND
1 B
W–R
W–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
ABS AND TRACTION ACTUATOR
E1
ABS AND TRACTION CONTROL
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
D4
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 2
(SHORT PIN)
11
B
C
12 IK2
23 A
4 B
R–L
BR
C
L
C
C
R–L
BR
R–L
L
2 IK1
LG–R
R–L
12
IG3
G–B
LG–R
C
G–B
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
LG–R
B
R–Y
R–L
5 IK2
E1
3
II3
B
8 IK2
TRC
17
L
R–L
(* 2)
(* 1)
LG–R
II3
ABS
14
LG–R
TC
4
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5
G–B
II3
R–Y
8
TC
11
G–B
R–Y
(* 2)
Y–B
(* 1)
R–L
II3
R–L
4
WA
22
P–B
TS
16
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG–R
WB
23
9 A
22 A
12 B
A15 A , A16 B , A17 C
TS
FL+
FL–
5 A
4 A
WA
TC
FR+
17 A
D/G
FR–
RL+
18 A
ABS AND TRACTION ECU
WT
RL–
2 B
RR+
1 B
9 B
RR–
10 B
A9
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
A10
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
A25
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR LH
1
2
A26
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR RH
(*2)
W–B
IL1
(*2)
3
B
IL1
(*1)
1
L(* 2)
P
IL1
(*2)
G
B
W
(* 2)
W
2
(*1)
BR(*2)
(*2)
1
2
(* 1)
1
Y
(SHIELDED)
2
(* 1)
1
R
G
R
2
4 ID1
(*2)
9 ID1
(SHIELDED)
G
3 ID1
(* 2)
W–B
R
6 IK2
B
G
1 IK2
W
R
W–B
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
R–L
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMMK MADE
10A
GAUGE
C 8 A , C10 C
COMBINATION METER
7 C
ABS
3 C
SLIP
4 C
R–L
TRAC OFF
2 1D
5 A
D
L
R–L
L
LG
19
IG3
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
R–L
18 IG3
R–L
LG
BR
J7 A ,
A15 A , A16 B , A17 C
ABS AND TRACTION ECU
C A
J8 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3 B
B B
EFI+
EFI–
6 B
14 B
13 B
5 B
B
LG
L
TRC+
TRC–
LG
NEO
15 B
W
CSW
11 B
BR–W
BR
IND
W–B(* 2)
4
T5
TRACTION
OFF SW
W–B
II3
1
NEO
14 A
21 A
EFI+
13 A
EFI–
20 A
TRC+
A B
TRC–
E 7 A , E 8 B , E10 D
J7 A ,
J8 B
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
W–B
16 B
A A
E2
W–B
18 D
VTA1
23 D
VC
2 D
L
Y
8 1J
BR
2
3
1
7 1J
A
IG
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
BR
(* 2)
W–B
A B
6
W–B
A B
(* 2)
W–B
(* 2)
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
T2
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
EC
ABS AND TRACTION CONTROL
SYSTEM OUTLINE
(ABS)
ABS is a brake system designed for the purpose to improve the operating ability securing the stability of the vehicle by
preventing the looking–up of the vehicle controlling the wheel cylinder pressure of all the four wheels at the time of sudden
braking.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) Speed sensor signal
The speed of the wheels is detected and input to TERMINALS FL+, FR+, RL+, and RR+ of the ABS and traction ECU.
(2) Stop light SW signal
A signal is input to TERMINAL STP of the ABS and traction ECU when brake pedal is depressed.
2. SYSTEM OPERATION
When the wheels are to be locked–up, the solenoid inside the actuator will be controlled by the signal from the ABS and
traction ECU and the brake fluid in the wheel cylinder will flow through the reservoir and reduce the hydraulic pressure.
While the ABS is in operation, as the ABS and traction ECU always outputs the operation signal to the pump inside the
actuator, brake fluid stored inside the reservoir will be suctioned up by the pump inside the actuator and returned to the
master cylinder.
When the hydraulic pressure of the wheel cylinder is decompressed or increased until the necessary hydraulic pressure, the
solenoid inside the actuator is controlled by the control signal from the ABS and traction ECU and as a result, hydraulic
pressure of the wheel cylinder will be closed at both routes of the master cylinder and reservoir sides and the hydraulic
pressure of the wheel cylinder will become to be in the holding condition.
If the increase of hydraulic pressure volume of the wheel cylinder becomes necessary, with the control signal from the ABS
and traction ECU, the solenoid inside the actuator will be controlled and become the same condition as usual and the brake
fluid of the master cylinder will be sent to the wheel cylinder and will increase the hydraulic pressure of the wheel cylinder. At
this time, in the case that the brake fluid stays left in the reservoir, it will be sucked up by the pump inside the actuator and
will be sent to the wheel cylinder.
Also, increasing speed of the hydraulic pressure is controlled by outputting the increasing and the said holding one after
another.
(Traction control)
Traction control system is designed to perform the engine output control by the fuel cut and hydraulic pressure control of
driving wheel brake and control the spinning of the driving wheels. By doing this, it improves starting acceleration and
operating ability of the vehicle securing the driving ability in accordance with the road surface condition.
3. TRACTION CONTROL OPERATION
Estimating the vehicle speed from the rear wheel speed, comparing it with the front, driving wheel speed and judging the grip
condition of the driving wheels. From the estimated vehicle speed, target speed of the driving speed will be set. When the
front, driving wheel speed exceeds the control starting speed, it judges that the tire slip is occurred and performs the fuel cut
cylinder number control and brake control and then adjust to make the front wheel speed become the traction control target
speed. Controlling of the traction control will be completed when the vehicle move onto the road where the driving wheels will
not have a tire slip or when the driver decelerate.
SERVICE HINTS
ABS MOTOR RELAY [R/B NO.3]
3–4 : Approx. 62 Ω
ABS SOL RELAY [R/B NO.3]
4–6 : Approx. 80 Ω
A9, A10 ABS SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH, RH
1–2 : 0.6 kΩ–2.5 kΩ
A15 (A), A16 (B), A17 (C) ABS AND TRACTION ECU
(B) 8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
(B)11–GROUND : Continuity with the ignition SW on and the traction off SW on (Traction control off)
(B)16–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the brake pedal depressed
(A)15, (C) 9, (C) 10–GROUND : Always continuity
A25, A26 ABS SPEED SENSOR REAR LH, RH
1–2 : 1.2 kΩ–2.3 kΩ
T2 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1–2 : 3.5 kΩ–5.0 kΩ
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
A7
A8
See Page
A
26 (1MZ–FE)
B
Code
C10
See Page
C
Code
See Page
30
J11
31
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
D1
26 (1MZ–FE)
J12
A9
26 (1MZ–FE)
D4
30
J22
A10
26 (1MZ–FE)
E7
A
30
J27
A
31
J28
B
31
31
A15
A
30
E8
B
30
A16
B
30
E10
D
30
J29
31
C
A17
30
J3
31
J32
31
A25
32
J4
31
S6
31
A26
32
J7
A
31
T2
27 (1MZ–FE)
30
J8
B
31
T5
31
C8
A
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
3
See Page
25
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Radiator Upper Support RH)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
1R
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
ID1
40
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
II3
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IK1
IK2
IL1
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EA
36 (1MZ–FE)
Right Radiator Side Support
EC
36 (1MZ–FE)
Surge Tank RH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E1
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
ABS AND TRACTION CONTROL
A7 (A)
A8 (B)
A9
A10
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
1
1 2
3 4
5 6
7 8
9 10 11 12
3
1
2
4
2
1
2
5
A15 (A)
A16 (B)
A17 (C)
A25
1 X X 4 5 X X X 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3 4 5 6 X 8
1 2 X 4 5 6
2 1
14 15 X 17 18 X X X 22 23 24 25 26
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
7 8 9 10 X 12
C8 (A)
C8 (A)
(TMC Made) BLUE
(TMMK Made) BLUE
A26
5
2 1
C10 (C)
C10 (C)
(TMMK Made) BROWN
X
X X
X X
5
(TMC Made) BROWN
3 4
X X
X
7
3 4
D4
DARK GRAY
X
X 11
X
16 X
X
X
17 X
X 14
X X X X X X
22 23
7
E7 (A)
D1
BLACK
X
X X 4 3 X X
X X
X X 13 14
20 21 X
E10 (D)
E8 (B)
E10 (D)
X X X
2
X
J3
(Except California) BLACK
(California)
X 2
X X 16 X X X
X
X X
X
18
18 X X
X X X
23
J4
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
C C C
B B B
X X
DDDX
(Hint : See Page 7)
B
B B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
23
J11
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
A A
C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J22
J12
BLACK
CCC
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J29
CC C
J32
S6
GRAY
BLUE
CC
CC
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
T5
BLACK
1 X X 4
T2
BLACK
1 2 3
1
2
ABS (TMC MADE)
BR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM
(SEE PAGE 50)
8
IK2
R–L
R–L
1
R–L
3
3
3
E1
(SHORT PIN)
ABS
6
3
WB
3
TC
14
4
IK1
TS
11
WA
16
22
II3
8
II3
5
II3
B
B LG–R
G–B
R–Y
GR–R
GR
W–L
W–R
GR–L
1
J3
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
LG–R
A
TC
11
W–B
3
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
23
G–B
4
D4
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
3
R–Y
2
II3
LG–R
5
LG–R
4
R–L
1
ABS SOL RELAY
ABS MOTOR RELAY
3
3
2
J22 (1MZ–FE)
J23 (5S–FE)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
1
3
GR–R
J7 A ,
BR
II3
B
A18 A , A19 B
1 A
A4 A , A5 B
ABS ACTUATOR
4 A
E
M
TS
SFLR
SFLH
11 A
6 A
5 A
SFRR
IK2
12
G–Y
2 B
SRLR
SFRH
1 B
8 B
SRLH
4 B
SRRR
7 B
SRRH
3 B
SFLR
10 A
R–B
IK2
11 IK2
5 B
SFLH
MT
2 B
W–R
12 A
R–W
SRRH
21 B
W–R
13
6 B
BS
TC
G–Y
5 IK2
LG–B
W–B
2 A
SRRR
15 B
LG–B
W–L
W–R
W–B
BM
EA
SRLH
14 B
D/G
ABS ECU
L–B
W–B
SRLR
E1
EC
R+
8 B
W–L
SR
24 B
W–R
MR
26 B
R–B
7 A
R–G
1 A
BR
6
4
3
BR
B B
GR–R
2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C A
J8 B
60A
FL ABS
1 B
SFRR
3 A
SFRH
MT
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
10A
GAUGE
15A
ECU–IG
9 1J
7 1C
W
R–L
2 1D
15A
STOP
D
2
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
D
7
A10
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
2
1
R
G
G–W
1
B–R
C10
ABS WARNING
LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
A9
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
2
1
1 IK2
6 IK2
4 1R
R–L
4
5 1R
G–B
G–W
12 IG3
A A
C
13 B
STP
RL+
FL+
RL–
9 B
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
B
3 A
9 A
FR+
FR–
RR+
RR–
10 B
23 B
1
2
2
B
IL1
1
IL1
B
G
9 ID1
G
3 ID1
A25
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR LH
IG
2 A
FL–
W
22 B
R
W–B
GND
12 B
W–B
GND2
25 B
8 A
5 B
IG1
R
WA
G–W
G–B
A18 A , A19 B
ABS ECU
11 B
G
C B
C
C
W
J27 A , A28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W
C
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
G–B
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
C
1
2
A26
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR RH
ABS (TMC MADE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
This system controls the respective brake fluid pressures acting on the disc brake cylinders of the right front wheel, left front
wheel and rear wheels when the brakes are applied in a panic stop so that the wheels do not lock. This results in improved
directional stability and steerability during panic braking.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) Speed sensor signal
The speed of the wheels is detected and input to TERMINALS FL+, FR+, RL+ and RR+ of the ABS ECU.
(2) Stop light SW signal
A signal is input to TERMINAL STP of the ABS ECU when the brake pedal is depressed.
2. SYSTEM OPERATION
During sudden braking the ABS ECU has signals input from each sensor, which controls the current to the solenoid inside
the actuator and lets the hydraulic pressure acting on each wheel cylinder escape to the reservoir. The pump inside the
actuator is also operating at this time and it returns the brake fluid from the reservoir to the master cylinder, thus preventing
locking of the vehicle wheels.
If the ABS ECU judges that the hydraulic pressure acting on the wheel cylinder is insufficient, the current on the solenoid is
controlled and the hydraulic pressure is increased. Holding of the hydraulic pressure is also controlled by the ABS ECU, by
the same method as above. Pressure reduction, holding and increase are repeated to maintain vehicle stability and to
improve steerability during sudden braking.
SERVICE HINTS
A9, A10 ABS SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH, RH
2–1 : 0.6 kΩ–2.5 kΩ
A25, A26 ABS SPEED SENSOR REAR LH, RH
2–1 : 1.2 kΩ–2.3 kΩ
A18 (A), A19 (B) ABS ECU
(Connect the ABS ECU connectors)
(B)21–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position and the data link connector 1
TS–E1, TC–E1 not connected
(B) 8–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position and the data link connector 1
TS–E1, TC–E1 not connected
(B)13–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
(B) 5–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the brake pedal depressed
(B)12, (B) 25–GROUND :
Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
A4
See Page
A
A5
Code
26 (1MZ–FE)
B
31
28 (5S–FE)
A26
32
J12
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
C10
30
J22
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J23
D1
28 (5S–FE)
J27
J28
B
31
D4
30
J3
31
J29
31
28 (5S–FE)
J4
31
S6
31
30
J7
A
31
A19
B
30
J8
B
31
: RELAY BLOCKS
See Page
25
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
A
3
31
A
28 (5S–FE)
A18
Code
See Page
J11
26 (1MZ–FE)
A10
Code
32
28 (5S–FE)
A9
See Page
A25
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Radiator Upper Support RH)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
1R
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
ID1
40
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
II3
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IK1
IK2
IL1
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
EA
38 (5S–FE)
EC
IG
Ground Points Location
Right Radiator Side Support
36 (1MZ–FE)
Surge Tank RH
38 (5S–FE)
Intake Manifold
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
E1
36 (1MZ–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
Engine Room Main Wire
E1
See Page
38 (5S–FE)
A4 (A)
A5 (B)
A9
A10
GRAY
BLACK
GRAY
GARY
1
1
1
3
4
2
1 2 3 4
X
5 6 7 8
A19 (B)
1 2 X X 5 X X 8 9 10 11 12 13
14 15 X X X X X 21 22 23 24 25 26
2
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
A18 (A)
1 2 3 X 5 6
2
7 8 9 10 11 12
A25
A26
2 1
2 1
C10
BROWN
4
7
ABS (TMC MADE)
D1
(1MZ–FE) BLACK
X X
X X
X
X
X X
X X
X
X
X
16 X
X
X X
X
X
X
X
X 11
X
16 X
X
X
X
22 23
X 14
X X X X X X
22 23
X X 4 3 X X
J4
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
C C C
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J3
B
B B B B
D4
DARK GRAY
X X
X
X 11
D1
(5S–FE) BLACK
X X
DDDX
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J12
J11
J22
J23
BLACK
A
A
A
A
A
CCC
A
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
J29
S6
BLUE
A A
C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
CC C
(Hint : See Page 7)
1
2
MEMO
ABS (TMMK MADE)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
1
15A
STOP
10A
GAUGE
15A
ECU–IG
60A
FL ABS
2
9 1J
R–L
W
D
C
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
R–L
4
1
12 IG3
L
B–R
5 IK3
R–L
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
7
B–R
C10
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
R–L
D
2
G–W
3
B–R
2 1D
7 1C
C
C
R–L
R–L
15
C
17
IG1
18
+B
+B
A6
ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
4 1R
WA
STP
FL+
FL–
FR+
FR–
21
14
7
6
5
4
(SHIELDED)
G
R
G–W
R–L
R–L
5 1R
(SHIELDED)
E2
10 IK3
1 IK3
1
IK2
6
IK2
13
IK2
A
A
B
W
G
(SHIELDED)
R
G–W
G–W
(SHIELDED)
C
B
J27 A , J28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
1
A9
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
2
1
A10
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
W–B
D4
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 2
D1
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 1
* 1 : 5S–FE
* 2 : 1MZ–FE
TC
TS
11
II3
(* 2)
R–Y
(* 1)
16
P–B
11
LG–R
BR
E1
3
LG–R
TC
4
R–L
ABS
14
8
II3
C
A
B
B
J7 A ,
LG–R
J8 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–Y
LG–R
B
B
B
6
IK2
BR
5
J22 (1MZ–FE)
J23 (5S–FE)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–Y
LG–R
12 IK2
II3
R–L
A
A
11
TS
RL–
RR+
RR–
9
8
2
1
L
P
Y
BR
RL+
W–B
GND2
16
W–B
GND1
19
12
TC
A6
ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
(SHIELDED)
9 ID1
Y
BR
3 ID1
IK3
7 IK3
2 IK3
4 ID1
3
IL1
6 IK3
(SHIELDED)
2
IL1
1
(SHIELDED)
1
EA
BR
8
L
IK3
IL1
L
9
P
IK3
Y
3
P
E1
(SHIELDED)
E1
W–B
(SHIELDED)
W–B
BR
E1
W–B
W–B
(SHIELDED)
2
A25
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR LH
1
2
A26
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR RH
EC
ABS (TMMK MADE)
SYSTEM OUTLINE
This system controls the respective brake fluid pressures acting on the disc brake cylinders of the right front wheel, left front
wheel and rear wheels when the brakes are applied in a panic stop so that the wheels do not lock. This results in improved
directional stability and steerability during panic braking.
1. INPUT SIGNALS
(1) Speed sensor signal
The speed of the wheels is detected and input to TERMINALS FL+, FR+, RL+ and RR+ of the ABS actuator and ECU.
(2) Stop light SW signal
A signal is input to TERMINAL STP of the ABS actuator and ECU when the brake pedal is depressed.
2. SYSTEM OPERATION
During sudden braking the ABS actuator and ECU has signals input from each sensor, which controls the current to the
solenoid inside the actuator and lets the hydraulic pressure acting on each wheel cylinder escape to the reservoir. The pump
inside the actuator is also operating at this time and it returns the brake fluid from the reservoir to the master cylinder, thus
preventing locking of the vehicle wheels.
If the ABS actuator and ECU judges that the hydraulic pressure acting on the wheel cylinder is insufficient, the current on the
solenoid is controlled and the hydraulic pressure is increased. Holding of the hydraulic pressure is also controlled by the
ABS actuator and ECU, by the same method as above. Pressure reduction, holding and increase are repeated to maintain
vehicle stability and to improve steerability during sudden braking.
SERVICE HINTS
A9, A10 ABS SPEED SENSOR FRONT LH, RH
2–1 : Approx. 1.6 kΩ
A25, A26 ABS SPEED SENSOR REAR LH, RH
2–1 : Approx. 1.6 kΩ
A6 ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
(Connect the ABS actuator and ECU connectors)
12–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position and the data link connector 1
TS–E1, TC–E1 not connected
11–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position and the data link connector 1
TS–E1, TC–E1 not connected
16, 19–GROUND : Always continuity
15–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
14–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the brake pedal depressed
17, 18–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
26 (1MZ–FE)
A6
28 (5S–FE)
D1
26 (1MZ–FE)
A9
A10
See Page
C10
Code
See Page
30
J12
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J22
31
28 (5S–FE)
J23
31
28 (5S–FE)
D4
30
J27
A
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
J3
31
J28
B
31
31
J29
31
A25
28 (5S–FE)
32
J7
J4
A
31
S6
31
A26
32
J8
B
31
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
3
See Page
25
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Fusible Link Block (Radiator Upper Support RH)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1C
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1D
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
1R
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
ID1
40
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
II3
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK2
42
IK3
42
IL1
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
Floor No.2 Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EA
EC
See Page
Ground Points Location
36 (1MZ–FE)
Right Radiator Side Support
38 (5S–FE)
36 (1MZ–FE)
Surge Tank RH
38 (5S–FE)
Intake Manifold
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E1
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
E2
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
A6
A9
A10
GRAY
GRAY
X X X X X 21 X
19
18
A26
2 1
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
BLACK
15 14 X 12 11 X 9 8 7 6 5 4 X 2 1
X X X X X
Code
17
1
2
2 1
2
16
C10
D1
BROWN
4
1
A25
7
(1MZ–FE) BLACK
X X
X
X X
X X
X
X
X
X 11
X
16 X
X
X
ABS (TMMK MADE)
D1
D4
(5S–FE) BLACK
DARK GRAY
X X
X
X X
X X
X
X
X
X 11
X
16 X
X
J3
B
B B B B
X
X
X 14
X X X X X X
(Hint : See Page 7)
X X 4 3 X X
J4
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
J12
BLACK
GRAY
GRAY
BLACK
X X
DD DX
C C C
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J22
J23
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J29
S6
BLUE
CC C
(Hint : See Page 7)
1
2
CCC
(Hint : See Page 7)
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
A A
C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
SRS
NOTICE: When inspecting or repairing the SRS, perform the operation in accordance with the following precautionary
instructions and the procedure and precautions in the Repair Manual for the applicable model year.
Malfunction symptoms of the SRS are difficult to confirm, so the DTCs become the most important source of information
when troubleshooting. When troubleshooting the SRS, always inspect the DTCs before disconnecting the battery.
Work must be started after 90 seconds from when the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the
negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back–up power source so that if work is started within 90 seconds from
disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may be deployed.)
When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the memory of the clock and audio system will be
canceled. So before starting work, make a record of the contents memorized in the audio memory system. When work is
finished, reset the audio systems as they were before and adjust the clock. To avoid erasing the memory in each
memory system, never use a back–up power supply from outside the vehicle.
Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor if shocks are likely to be applied to the sensor during repairs.
Do not expose the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly, seat belt pretensioner,
center airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensor assembly or side airbag sensor assembly directly to hot air or
flames.
Even in cases of a minor collision where the SRS does not deploy, the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag
assembly, side airbag assembly, seat belt pretensioner, center airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensor assembly
and side airbag sensor assembly should be inspected.
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
Never disassemble and repair the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly, seat belt
pretensioner, center airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensor assembly or side airbag sensor assembly in order to
reuse it.
If the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly, seat belt pretensioner, center airbag
sensor assembly, front airbag sensor assembly or side airbag sensor assembly has been dropped, or if there are
cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or connector, replace them with new ones.
Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V minimum) for troubleshooting the system’s electrical circuits.
Information labels are attached to the periphery of the SRS components. Follow the instructions on the notices.
After work on the SRS is completed, perform the SRS warning light check.
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precaution in the IN section of the Repair
Manual.
SRS
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
15A
CIG
2 1N
7 2J
26 B
15 B
6 B
20 B
9 B
7 A
3
9 A
4
10 A
(* 3)
GR–L
2
(* 3)
2 IU1
1
LG–B
B–W
1 IU1
B–W
IT1
W–R
S7
SIDE AIRBAG
SENSOR LH
(* 3)
GR
1
2
1G
A
BR–W
2
W–R
5 B
IT1
BR
1
B
3
1W
W–R
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
2
BR–W
BR
1
A
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
2
W–R
B–O
B
A32
AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT RH
(* 3)
A31
AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT LH
P–L
4 1N
10A
ECU–B
L–W
5A
IGN
12 A
C17 A , C18 B , C19 C
Y
Y–R
Y–G
1 BV1
3 1V
SPIRAL
CABLE
W–B
W–B
1
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
IE
Y–G
Y–R
2
A23
AIRBAG SQUIB
(STEERING
WHEEL PAD)
2
A22
AIRBAG SQUIB
(FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY)
1
2
S9
SIDE AIRBAG
SQUIB LH
(* 2 *3)
3 1N
1
7 1J
2 BV1
(* 2 *3)
1 1N
Y–G
Y–B
6 A
(*2 * 3)
W–B
5 A
Y–R
11 B
(* 1 * 3)
10 B
(* 1 * 3)
13 B
Y–R
14 B
Y–R
28 B
(*2 * 3)
27 B
W–B
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
AB
TC
E1
BR
(* 4)
3
P–B
(* 4)
LG–R
11
B–Y
LG
5
(* 5)
* 4 : TMMK MADE 1MZ–FE
* 5 : EXCEPT * 4
(* 5)
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMMK MADE
* 3 : W/ SIDE AIRBAG
W–R
1
2
3
II3
11
LG
LG
13
7
II3
LG–R
C9
SRS WARNING
LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
12
S8
SIDE AIRBAG
SENSOR RH
4
2 IG2
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
A
B
10 C
9 C
7 C
3 B
19 B
LG–R
P–B
12 C
B
B–Y
A
D4
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
GR
LG
(* 3)
LG
(* 3)
(* 3)
L–Y
(* 3)
P
A
C17 A , C18 B , C19 C
4
TC
E1
3
BR
BR
B B
W
Y–G
(* 2 * 3)
Y–R
C
(* 2 * 3)
J8 B
W
2 BW1
6
2
1
2
P24
PRETENSIONER
LH
S10
SIDE AIRBAG
SQUIB RH
P25
PRETENSIONER
RH
II3
7
BR
1
D5
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
2
SIL
1
J22 (1MZ–FE)
J23 (5S–FE)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
1 BW1
C A
A
A
A
BR
Y
L–B(*2)
Y–B(* 1)
C
J7 A ,
12 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
6 C
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
5 C
Y
Y–G
(* 2 * 3)
Y–G
(* 1 * 3)
1 C
(* 1 * 3)
Y–R
2 C
Y–R
1 A
(* 2 * 3)
2 A
Y–B
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
EC
SRS
SYSTEM OUTLINE
The SRS is a driver and front passenger protection device which has a supplemental role to the seat belts.
When the ignition SW is turned to ACC or ON, current from the CIG fuse flows to TERMINAL (B) 6 of the center airbag
sensor assembly. Only when the ignition SW is on does the current flow from the IGN fuse to TERMINAL (B) 5 of the center
airbag sensor assembly.
If an accident occurs while driving, when the frontal impact exceeds a set level, current from the CIG or IGN fuse flows to
TERMINALS (B) 14, (B) 10, (A) 2 and (C) 5 of the center airbag sensor assembly to TERMINAL 1 of the airbag squibs and
the pretensioners to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINALS (B) 13, (B) 11, (A) 1 and (C) 6 of the center airbag sensor assembly to
TERMINAL (B) 27, (B) 28 or BODY GROUND to GROUND, so that current flows to the front airbag squibs and the
pretensioners and causes them to operate.
When the side impact also exceeds a set level, current from the CIG or IGN fuse flows to TERMINALS (A) 5, (C) 2, (A) 2 and
(C) 5 of the center airbag sensor assembly to TERMINAL 1 of the side airbag squibs and the pretensioners to TERMINAL 2
to TERMINALS (A) 6, (C) 1, (A) 1 and (C) 6 of the center airbag sensor assembly to TERMINAL (B) 27, (B) 28 or BODY
GROUND to GROUND, causing side airbag squibs and the pretensioners to operate.
The airbag stored inside the steering wheel pad is instantaneously expanded to soften the shock to the driver.
The airbag stored inside the passenger’s instrument panel is instantaneously expanded to soften the shock to the front
passenger.
Side airbags are instantaneously expanded to soften the shock of side to the driver and front passenger.
The pretensioners make sure of the seat belt restrainability.
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A22
30
D4
30
P24
33
A23
30
D5
30
P25
33
C9
30
J3
31
S7
33
C17
A
30
J7
A
31
S8
33
C18
B
30
J8
B
31
S9
34
C19
C
30
J11
31
S10
34
26 (1MZ–FE)
J22
31
28 (5S–FE)
J23
31
D1
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1G
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1N
1V
1W
2J
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IG2
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
II3
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IT1
42
Cowl Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IU1
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BV1
46
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Driver’s Seat)
BW1
46
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Front Passenger’s Seat)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
36 (1MZ–FE)
Surge Tank RH
38 (5S–FE)
Intake Manifold
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
EC
A22
A23
A31
A32
YELLOW
YELLOW
YELLOW
YELLOW
1
1 2
1
2
2
1
2
C9
C9
C17 (A)
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
YELLOW
A
12 13
12 13
B
1 2 XX5 6
7 X 9 10 X 12
C18 (B)
C19 (C)
D1
YELLOW
YELLOW
(1MZ–FE) BLACK
A
A B
X X 3
X 5 6
B
X X 3
1 2 XX5 6
X X 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 X X
7 X 9 10 X 12
X X
D1
D4
(5S–FE) BLACK
DARK GRAY
X
X
X 11
X
X
X
X
X 11
X
X
X
X
D5
X
X X
X X
5 X
5 X
X
X X
X 19 20 X X X X X 26 27 28
X X 3
X
X
J3
A A B
C C
A A B B B B C C
X
X
X X X X X X
X X X X X X X
X X 4 3 X X
X 7 X X X X
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
GRAY
GRAY
C C C
B B B
J11
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
SRS
J22
J23
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
S9
S10
YELLOW
YELLOW
1 2
1 2
P24
P25
S7
S8
YELLOW
YELLOW
YELLOW
YELLOW
1 2
1 2
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
MEMO
SHIFT LOCK
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
15A
CIG
15A
ECU–IG
8 1D
7 1C
W
1 1T
15A
STOP
P–L
B–R
2
S6
STOP LIGHT
SW
C
A
C
1
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4 1R
P–L
B–R
A
G–W
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–W
2 1H
1
3
ACC
S3
SHIFT LOCK ECU
IG
6
SHIFT LOCK
CONTROL SW
STP
P1
P
P2
SLS–
G–R
3
G
2
G–W
1
L
SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID
SLS+
KLS+
E
5
W–B
L–B
4
L–B
5 IG1
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
K3
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
W–B
W–B
A
8
1J
7
1J
W–B
W–B
1
A
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
IF
L–R
2
1
SYSTEM OUTLINE
When the ignition SW is turned to ACC position the current from the CIG fuse flows to TERMINAL 1 of the shift lock ECU, in
the ON position, the current from the ECU–IG fuse flows to TERMINAL 3 of the ECU.
1. SHIFT LOCK MECHANISM
With the ignition SW on, when a signal that the brake pedal is depressed (Stop light SW on) and a signal that the shift lever
is put in P position (Continuity between P1 and P of the shift lock control SW) is input to the shift lock ECU, the ECU
operates and current flows from TERMINAL 3 of the ECU to TERMINAL SLS+ of the shift lock solenoid to solenoid to
TERMINAL SLS– to TERMINAL 5 of the ECU to GROUND. This causes the shift lock solenoid to turn on (Plate stopper
disengages) and the shift lever can shift into position other than the P.
2. KEY INTERLOCK MECHANISM
With the ignition SW ON or ACC position, when the shift lever is put in P position (No continuity between P2 and P of shift
lock control SW), the current flowing from TERMINAL 4 of the shift lock ECU to the key interlock solenoid is cut off. This
causes the key interlock solenoid to turn off (Lock lever disengages from LOCK position) and the ignition key can be turned
from ACC to LOCK position.
SERVICE HINTS
S3 SHIFT LOCK ECU
1–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
3–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
5–GROUND : Always continuity
6–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the brake pedal depressed
S6 STOP LIGHT SW
2–1 : Closed with the brake pedal depressed
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
J5
31
J11
31
S3
31
J6
31
J16
31
S6
31
J7
31
K3
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1C
1D
1H
1J
1R
1T
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
IG1
See Page
40
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
SHIFT LOCK
J5
J6
J7
A A A A A
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
A
A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J16
K3
BLACK
C C
1 2
(Hint : See Page 7)
S6
S3
BLUE
1X3
4 5 6
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
BLACK
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J11
GRAY
ORANGE
1
2
MEMO
HORN
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
10A
HORN
1
5
2
3
10 2K
1 2F
G–B
G–W
HORN
RELAY
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
G–B
G–W
C
6
C12
HORN SW
[COMB. SW]
G–W
1
H5
HORN
(HIGH)
1
H6
HORN
(LOW)
SERVICE HINTS
HORN RELAY [ENGINE ROOM J/B NO.2]
5–3 : Closed with the horn SW on
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
C12
30
H5
28 (5S–FE)
H6
28 (5S–FE)
H5
26 (1MZ–FE)
H6
26 (1MZ–FE)
J2
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
2F
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2K
22
Cowl Wire And Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
C12
H5
H6
J2
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
1
XX 6
1
CCC
(Hint : See Page 7)
CIGARETTE LIGHTER AND CLOCK
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
15A
CIG
7. 5A
PANEL
1 1T
5 1D
12 2J
G
R
6 1J
7. 5A
DOME
P–L
1 1W
A A
J30 A , J31 B
R–Y
P–L
A B
8 1G
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
A
D10
DIODE
(DOME)
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
R
A
D
B
E
A
G
J16 A , J17 B
R
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C4
CIGARETTE
LIGHTER
1
P–L
2
3
1
C6
CLOCK
2
W–B
W–B
4
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
A
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
IF
SERVICE HINTS
C4 CIGARETTE LIGHTER
2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
1–GROUND : Always continuity
C6 CLOCK
4–GROUND :
1–GROUND :
2–GROUND :
3–GROUND :
Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
Always approx. 12 volts
Always continuity
Approx. 12 volts with the light control SW at TAIL or HEAD position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
C4
30
Code
See Page
J6
J11
Code
See Page
31
J30
A
31
31
J31
B
31
C6
30
D10
30
J16
A
31
J5
31
J17
B
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
1D
1G
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1T
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2J
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
C4
C6
D10
J5
BLACK
BLACK
ORANGE
J6
1
1 2
2
1 2 3 4
A A A A A
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J11
A
A
J16 (A)
J17 (B)
J30 (A)
BLACK
BLACK
GRAY
A A A A A A
E E E
D D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J31 (B)
GRAY
A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
KEY REMINDER AND SEAT BELT WARNING
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
* 1 : W/ POWER SEAT
10A
GAUGE
R–L
D
D
R–L
7. 5A
DOME
2
1D
12 2J
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 C
C 8 A , C10 C
R
SEAT BELT
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
R–W
4 A
1 1W
3 1T
9
INTEGRATION RELAY
7
1
BUZZER
6
8
7 1S
4 1S
W–B
R–Y
2
(* 1)
R–Y
3 BQ1
1
3 1M
1
1
D12
DOOR COURTESY
SW FRONT LH
B7
BUCKLE
SW LH
2
B6
BUCKLE
SW LH
2
W–B
(* 1)
W–B
7 1J
A
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
(* 1)
W–B
W–B
1 BQ1
A
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BL
(W/O POWER SEAT)
U1
UNLOCK
WARNING SW
(W/O POWER SEAT)
R–Y
R–G
1
(* 1)
5
5 1M
L–B
10
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current always flows to TERMINAL 1 of the integration relay through the DOME fuse.
1. SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
When the ignition SW is turned on, current flows from the GAUGE fuse to TERMINAL 7 of the integration relay. At the same
time, current flows to TERMINAL 9 of the relay from the GAUGE fuse through the seat belt warning light. This current
activates the relay and the current flowing through the warning light flows from TERMINAL 9 of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to
GROUND, causing the warning light to light up. A buckle SW off signal is input to TERMINAL 8 of the relay to TERMINAL 10
to GROUND, causing the warning light to light up. A buckle SW off signal is input to TERMINAL 8 of the relay, the current
flowing to TERMINAL 1 of the relay flows from TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and the seat belt warning buzzer sounds for
approx. 6 seconds. However, if the seat belt is put on during this period (While the buzzer is sounding), signal input to
TERMINAL 8 of the relay stops and the current flow from TERMINAL 1 of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND is cut,
causing the buzzer to stop.
2. KEY REMINDER SYSTEM
With the ignition key inserted in the key cylinder (Unlock warning SW on), the ignition SW still off and driver’s door open
(Door courtesy SW on), when a signal is input to TERMINAL 6 of the integration relay, the relay operates, current flows from
TERMINAL 1 of the relay to TERMINAL 10 to GROUND and key reminder buzzer sounds.
SERVICE HINTS
B6, B7 BUCKLE SW LH
1–2 : Closed with driver’s seat belt in use
D12 DOOR COURTESY SW FRONT LH
1–GROUND : Closed with front LH door open
U1 UNLOCK WARNING SW
1–2 : Closed with ignition key in cylinder
INTEGRATION RELAY [INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B]
10–GROUND : Always continuity
6–GROUND : Continuity with the driver’s door open
5–GROUND : Continuity with the ignition key in cylinder
8–GROUND : Continuity with the driver’s seat belt in use
1–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
B6
32
B7
C8
A
Code
C10
See Page
C
1D
31
34
D12
32
J40
32
30
J4
31
U1
31
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1S
20
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1T
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2J
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1M
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
BQ1
See Page
46
See Page
J11
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
Code
30
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Driver’s Seat)
KEY REMINDER AND SEAT BELT WARNING
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
B6
C8 (A)
B7
C8 (A)
(TMC Made) BLUE
1 2
4
1 2
4
C10 (C)
C10 (C)
D12
(TMMK Made) BROWN
(TMC Made) BROWN
(TMMK Made) BLUE
1
7
J11
J4
7
J40
U1
BLACK
X X
DDDX
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
1 2
MEMO
POWER OUTLET
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
15A
POWER–
OUTLET
V
5 1J
2
P4
POWER
OUTLET
W–B
1
4 1V
W–B
3 1V
IE
SERVICE HINTS
P4 POWER OUTLET
2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
1–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
P4
Code
See Page
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1J
1V
See Page
20
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
IE
See Page
40
P4
ORANGE
1
2
Ground Points Location
Cowl Side Panel LH
Code
See Page
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
* 1 : TMMK MADE
* 2 : TMC MADE W/ MIRROR HEATER
* 3 : TMC MADE W/O MIRROR HEATER
15A
CIG
P–L
1 1T
A
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
P–L
A
R6
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
9
M
M
LG–R
BR–R
LG–B
LG–R
14 IM1
15 IM1
2 A (*1)
3 B (*2)
2 C (*3)
1 A
4 B
3 C
3 A
2 B
1 C
M
M
R16 A , B , C
R17 A , B , C
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH
LG–R
3 A
2 B
1 C
16 IM1
LG–B
1 A
4 B
3 C
15 IE1
BR–R
BR–Y
IE1
BR–W
14
LG–R
BR–Y
C
OPERATION SW
SELECT SW
E
6
10
W–B
LG–B
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
M+
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
7
BR–Y
VR
1
BR–R
VL
8
BR–W
HR
5
16 IE1
RIGHT/
DOWN
LEFT/
UP
MV
LG–R
MH
HL
DOWN
UP
LEFT
RIGHT
B
2 A (* 1)
3 B (* 2)
2 C (* 3)
IF
SERVICE HINTS
R6 REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
9–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
6–10 : Continuity with the operation SW at UP or LEFT position
9–6 : Continuity with the operation SW at DOWN or RIGHT position
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
J4
31
J5
31
J6
31
R6
31
Code
R16
R17
See Page
A
33
B
33
C
33
A
33
Code
R17
See Page
B
33
C
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
1T
20
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
IF
40
Ground Points Location
Left Kick Panel
J4
J5
BLACK
ORANGE
X X
CCC X
(Hint : See Page 7)
J6
A A A A A
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
R6
1
5 6 7
X X
8 9 10
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
R16 (A), R17 (A)
R16 (A), R17 (A)
R16 (B), R17 (B)
R16 (C), R17 (C)
(TMMK Made w/ Mirror Heater)
(TMMK Made w/o Mirror Heater)
(TMC Made w/ Mirror Heater)
(TMC Made w/o Mirror Heater)
3 2 1
X
234
1
2
3
1 2
3
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER AND MIRROR HEATER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
* 3 : AUTOMATIC A/C
* 4 : MANUAL A/C
* 1 : TMC MADE
* 2 : TMMK MADE
1
10A
HEATER
40A
DEF
10A
MIRROR–
HEATER
2
1
5
NOISE
FILTER
2
DEFOGGER
RELAY
4 1D
7 1J
W–B
B–Y
B
5 1T
B–Y
1 1L
L–B
3
13 1J
(*3)
Y–G
Y–G
12 1J
(*4)
3 1R
L–B
1
2
5 IE1
5 IM1
A
IG
(* 1)
W–B
(*2)
R17 A ,
W–B
7 1G
W–B
1 B
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
20 IM1
3 1V
W–B
N2
NOISE FILTER
(REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER)
A
W–B
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
A
(*1)
W–B
W–B
A
20 IE1
B
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
J39
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
1 A
(W/ AUTO ANTENNA)
(* 4)
W–B
3
R14 A , R15 B
TIMER
CIRCUIT
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
1
5 A (*1)
4 B (*2)
(*2)
B
R16 A ,
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
(W/ AUTO ANTENNA)
B
5
(W/O AUTO ANTENNA)
4
5 A (*1)
4 B (*2)
(* 1)
(* 4)
L–B
A34
A/C CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
1 A (*1)
6 B (*2)
B
1 A (*1)
6 B (*2)
RDFG
W–B
8 ID1
23
A
MIRROR HEATER RH
[REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR RH]
W–B
B–Y
A
(*1)
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
MIRROR HEATER LH
[REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR LH]
W–B
B–Y
A
W–B
BO
IE
IJ
SERVICE HINTS
DEFOGGER RELAY [INSTRUMENT PANEL J/B]
5–3 : Closed with the ignition SW on and the rear window defogger SW on
R5 REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SW
4–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW on
3–GROUND : Always continuity
5–GROUND : Continuity with the rear window defogger SW on and approx. 15 minutes thereafter
R16 (A), (B), R17 (A), (B) MIRROR HEATER LH, RH [REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR LH, RH]
(A)1, (B) 6–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the rear window defogger SW on
(A)5, (B) 4–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A34
30
N2
33
J11
31
R5
31
J32
31
R14
A
33
J38
32
R15
B
33
J39
32
R16
A
33
Code
R16
R17
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1D
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
1T
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1V
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
1J
1L
1R
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
ID1
40
Floor Wire and Cowl Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IE1
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IJ
40
Right Kick Panel
BO
44
Right Quarter Pillar
See Page
B
33
A
33
B
33
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER AND MIRROR HEATER
A34
J11
J32
J38
GRAY
A
X
A
X X 23 X X
A
A
A
A A
A A
A A A
A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J39
A A A
X X
A A A X X X X
N2
R5
R14 (A)
R15 (B)
R16 (A)
BLACK
BLACK
BLACK
(TMC Made)
1
15
1
X
1
(Hint : See Page 7)
3 4 5
R16 (B)
R17 (A)
R17 (B)
(TMMK Made)
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
6 X 4
15
6 X 4
MEMO
AUTO ANTENNA
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
* 1 : BUILT–IN TYPE AMPLIFIER
* 2 : SEPARATE TYPE AMPLIFIER
20A
RADIO
NO. 1
15A
ECU–IG
3 1H
8 1D
L–Y
11 2K
7. 5A
RAD–
NO. 2
5 1W
R3
RADIO AND PLAYER
L–Y
6 1G
4
(* 1)
GR
3
B–R
B–R
(* 2)
3
IH1
GR
(* 2)
B A
A A
A A
ANT+B
S4 A , S5 B
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
7
L–Y
A +B
(* 2)
4
IH1
L–Y
B A
8
(* 1)
ACC+B
GR
(* 2)
2
B ACC
C A
R4
RADIO AND PLAYER
J16 A , J17 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
B–R
3 IN1
1 IN1
B–R
B–R
2
5
4
ACC
IG
8
(* 2)
E
A27
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
ANT+B
ANT
6
W–B
B6
W–B
+B
R–B
(*1)
GR
4 IN1
GR
(* 2)
5 IN1
3
8
IH1
B–R
A B
L–Y
C B
L–Y
B B
IK
W–B
GR
(*1)
GR
(*1)
L–Y
L–Y
(* 1)
+B
BN
SERVICE HINTS
A27 AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR AND RELAY
3–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
5–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ACC or ON position
6–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
A27
Code
See Page
32
R3
31
R4
31
J16
A
31
J17
B
31
S4
A
Code
See Page
S5
B
31
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1D
1G
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
1W
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2K
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1H
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IH1
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel No.2 Wire (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
IN1
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
IK
40
Right Kick Panel
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
B6
44
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Floor No.2 Wire
A27
J16 (A)
J17 (B)
BLACK
BLACK
A A B B C C
A A B B C C
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
R3
X
3 4
2
5 6
R4
8
X
S4 (A)
3 4
8 X
S5 (B)
X X
7
X X X
X
2
X X
RADIO AND PLAYER (SEPARATE TYPE AMPLIFIER)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
20A
RADIO
NO. 1
7. 5A
RAD–NO. 2
B–R
3 1H
1 IN1
5 1W
ANT
A27
AUTO ANTENNA
MOTOR AND RELAY
B–R
L–Y
11 2K
4
R–B
GR
8 IH1
6 1G
R4
RADIO AND PLAYER
ANT+B
GND
BEEP
RL
13
RR
14
15
G
12
Y
7
12 B
5 B
6 B
11 B
4 B
13 B
14 B
I4
1 B
AMP+
ACC
3 B
9 B
R+B
13 A
RACC
GND
MUTE
FLIN
FRIN
SGND
BEEP
RLIN
RRIN
S4 A , S5 B
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
Y
R
W
F10
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
IH
3 A
R
4
1
2
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
IF1
W
IF1
L
10
R
Y
IF1
Y
3
10 A
W
B
2
IF1
1
L
V
1
F13
FRONT TWEETER
(SPEAKER) RH
2
1
LG
P
P
BR
F12
FRONT TWEETER
(SPEAKER) LH
2
1
9
B
1 IM1
P
9 IM1
B
L
3 IH2
L
1 IH2
LG
6 IH2
LG
2 IH2
V
5 IH1
1 IE1
11 A
RR–
1 IH1
IE1
4 A
RR+
6 IH1
9
8 A
RL–
2 IH1
7 IH1
1 A
RL+
2 A
LG
FR–
10 B
V
9 A
FR+
V
FL–
P
FL+
BR
E
1
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
GND
11
(SHIELDED)
FR
6
R
W
FL
5
W
B
MUTE
B
3
L
2 B
+B
ACC
4
GR
7 A
+B
1
R
3 IH1
GR
4 IH1
L–Y
GR
A
L–Y
B
AMP+B
BR
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
(SHIELDED)
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
L–Y
8
SERVICE HINTS
S4 (A), S5 (B) STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(A) 7–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(B) 2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ACC position
(B)10–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A27
32
F13
32
R13
33
F10
32
J16
31
S4
A
31
F11
32
R4
31
S5
B
31
F12
32
R12
33
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1G
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2K
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1H
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel No.2
No 2 Wire (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
IM1
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IN1
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IH1
IH2
: GROUND POINTS
Code
IH
See Page
40
Ground Points Location
Instrument Panel Brace RH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I4
See Page
42
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Instrument Panel No.2 Wire
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
RADIO AND PLAYER (SEPARATE TYPE AMPLIFIER)
A27
X
4
F10
F11
BLUE
BLUE
1 2
1 2
F12
F13
J16
BLACK
1
2
1
2
A A B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
R4
1 3 4
8
5 6 7
X 11 12 13
S5 (B)
1 2 3
4 5 6
X X 9 1011121314
14 15
R12
R13
1 2
1 2
S4 (A)
1 2
3 4
X X
7
8 9
10 11 X 13 X X
X
MEMO
RADIO AND PLAYER (BUILT–IN TYPE AMPLIFIER)
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
20A
RADIO
NO. 1
7. 5A
RAD–NO. 2
A27
AUTO ANTENNA
MOTOR AND RELAY
3 1H
L–Y
11 2K
GR
ANT
B–R
5 1W
4
L–Y
6 1G
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
B
A
1 IN1
L–Y
GR
B–R
B
4 A
3 A
R2 B , R3 A
2
BR
F10
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
1
2
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
IF1
3
IF1
1
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
RR–
R
W
3 B
10
IF1
4
IF1
W
9
RR+
1 B
Y
1 IM1
B
9 IM1
RL–
6 B
R
RL+
2 B
Y
V
1
IH
IE1
FR–
5 A
B
V
BR
P
1
P
IE1
FR+
1 A
L
FL–
6 A
L
FL+
2 A
9
ANT+B
LG
GND
7 A
8 A
ACC
LG
+B
RADIO AND PLAYER
1
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
SERVICE HINTS
R3 (A) RADIO AND PLAYER
(A) 4–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 3–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON or ACC position
(A) 7–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
A27
32
F10
32
R2
F11
32
R3
See Page
J16
Code
See Page
31
R12
33
B
31
R13
33
A
31
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
1G
1H
1W
2K
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IE1
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF1
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IM1
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IN1
42
Floor No.2 Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
IH
See Page
40
A27
Ground Points Location
Instrument Panel Brace RH
F10
F11
J16
BLUE
BLUE
BLACK
R2 (B)
1
X
4
1 2
1 2
A A B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
R3 (A)
1 2
R12
R13
1 2
1 2
3 4
5 6 7 8 X
2
3 X 6
COMBINATION METER
R
V–W
8 1G
R–Y
E
V–W
E
2
3
IG3
V–W
D10
DIODE
(DOME)
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP
WATER TEMP.
6 C
10 B
2 A
1 A
BR
DOOR
15 B
R–W
8 C
L
6 IG3
10 IG3
3
IH
IJ1
G–R
6
Y–G
BR
IJ1
IG+
1
1
W3
WATER
TEMP.
SENDER
BR
R–L
SE
3
R–L
IF2
BR
1
J21 (* 2) ,
J24 (* 1)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
A
V2
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(COMBINATION METER)
FROM ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE
BR
3
IJ1
2
SI
F14
FUEL SENDER
2
BR
2
IJ1
TO DOOR
COURTESY SW
1
7
P
IF2
L
4
B–O
IF2
G–W
3
Y–R
II2
R–L
2
2 C
TO ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE
5 C
11 B
P
TRIP METER
ODOMETER
SPEEDOMETER
14 B
B–O
TACHO
FUEL
3 B
BR
R–L
Y–R
6 B
COMBINATION METER
G–W
FUEL
7 C
1
G–R
R–L
J28
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
V–W
B
D
1 1W
Y–G
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
R
F
D
12 2J
R
F
7. 5A
DOME
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
V–W
R–L
R–L
2 1D
R–L
1 1J
TO A/C CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
10A
GAUGE
TO CRUISE
CONTROL ECU
TO ENGINE
CONTROL MODULE
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
ED : * 1
EC : * 2
GR
GR
B–W
(A/T)
10
II2
C7
CLUTCH START SW
1
2
B–W
6 IG1
B–O
B
R–Y
B–O
B
(*6 A/T)
GR
B
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
(A/T)
II2
(* 5 A/T)
6
11
C B
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
N
B–W
FROM THEFT
DETERRENT ECU
P
B–O
(M/T)
(*6)
J7 A ,
5
3 1J
B–O
B A
(A/T)
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
* 3 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 4 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 5 : TMC MADE
* 6 : TMMK MADE
(* 5)
B–W
J8 B
5A
STARTER
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
(M/T)
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
COMBINATION METER
O/D OFF
LG
G–O
L
12 A
TO O/D
MAIN SW
R–W
TO ABS AND
TRACTION
ECU
B
B
R–W
R–W
B
R–W
8 A (*1)
14 B (*2)
2
B2
BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL WARNING SW
B
PKB
(* 3)
BRK
D6 A ,
18 A (*1)
4 B (*2)
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
(* 4)
R–W
Y–G
W1
WASHER LEVEL
WARNING SW
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
P–L
P–L
TO ABS ECU
TO ABS AND TRACTION ECU
TO ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
TO INTEGRATION
RELAY
SLIP
5 A
IF2
IK2
1
TRAC OFF
BULB
CHECK
RELAY
3 C
3 IG2
5
3
TO CRUISE
CONTROL ECU
7 B
R–W
3 A
Y–G
17 IG3
O
IJ1
BRAKE
REAR LIGHTS
WASHER LEVEL
11 C
P–L
4 C
R–L
ABS
SEAT BELT
4 A
R–W
CRUISE
10 C
5 IG2
1
2
1
W–B
R–W
(* 4)
TO LIGHT
FAILURE
SENSOR
P3
PARKING
BRAKE SW
7 IG1
R–W
EB
1
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
O1
OIL PRESSURE
SW
W–B
5
2 B
O
OIL
Y–B
5 B
Y–B
SECURITY
9 C
A
IG
COMBINATION METER
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
5A
IGN
FROM A/T INDICATOR LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
8 1T
16 B
G
13 C
ILLUMINATION
6 A
L
2
P
4 B
Y
O
11 A
(* 5)
B–R
7 A
L–W
R
10 A
(* 6)
R–B
8 A
D
G–W
9 A
N
B–R
13 A
R
G–Y
1 C
CHARGE
G–B
G
1 B
12 C
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
B
Y
W–B
COMBINATION METER
B
R7
RHEOSTAT
2
D
D
ILL
FROM GENERATOR
E
T
1
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
3
G
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
TURN RH
TURN LH
FROM HAZARD SW OR
TURN SIGNAL SW
[COMB. SW]
IF
A
W–B
A
W–B
W–B
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
* 3 : W/O DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
* 4 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
R–L
7. 5A
PANEL
10A
ECU–B
FROM HEADLIGHT LH, RH
(* 3)
R–W
FROM DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
(* 4)
7 2J
G
W–R
5 1D
3 IG1
G
A
A
A
2 1G
W–R
J30
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
3 1W
W–B
W–B
G
COMBINATION METER
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
9 B
LG
SRS
13 B
TO CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
G
8 B
HIGH BEAM
12 B
* 5 : TMC MADE
* 6 : TMMK MADE
COMBINATION METER
SERVICE HINTS
B2 BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SW
1–2 : Closed with the float down
C8 (A), C9 (B), C10 (C) COMBINATION METER
(B) 2–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ST position and the shift lever at P or N position (A/T)
Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ST position and the clutch pedal depressed (M/T)
(A) 13, (C) 7–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
(B)11, (B) 12–GROUND: Always approx. 12 volts
(A) 2, (B) 9, (B) 16, (C) 5–GROUND : Always continuity
O1 OIL PRESSURE SW
1–GROUND : Closed with the oil pressure above approx. 20 kpa (2.8 psi, 0.2 kgf/cm2)
P3 PARKING BRAKE SW
1–GROUND : Closed with the parking brake lever pulled up
W3 WATER TEMP. SENDER
1–GROUND : Approx. 160–240 Ω (50°C, 122°F)
Approx. 17.1–21.2 Ω (120°C, 248°F)
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
26 (1MZ–FE)
B2
C7
See Page
J5
31
28 (5S–FE)
J7
A
31
30
J8
B
31
Code
O1
P1
See Page
29 (5S–FE)
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
C8
A
30
J11
31
P3
31
C9
B
30
J15
31
R7
31
C10
C
30
J16
31
A
30
J21
31
B
D6
30
J24
31
D10
30
J28
31
F14
32
J29
31
J2
31
J30
31
J4
31
O1
27 (1MZ–FE)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
1D
1G
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1J
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1T
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1W
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2J
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
IF2
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IG1
40
IG2
40
IG3
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Under The Blower Motor)
II2
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IJ1
42
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK2
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
V2
W1
W3
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
36 (1MZ–FE)
EB
Left Radiator Side Support
38 (5S–FE)
EC
38 (5S–FE)
Intake Manifold
ED
36 (1MZ–FE)
Rear Side of the Surge Tank
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
B2
C8 (A)
C7
GRAY
1
C8 (A)
(TMC Made) BLUE
2
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2
(TMMK Made) BLUE
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
C9 (B)
(TMMK Made)
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
C10 (C)
(TMMK Made) BROWN
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2 3 4 5 6
X X
X X
X
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
D6 (B)
D10
(TMMK Made)
BLACK
D6 (A)
(TMC Made) GRAY
X
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
C10 (C)
(TMC Made) BROWN
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
C9 (B)
(TMC Made)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2
8
X 4
18
F14
1
2
3
X X X X X
14 X X
J2
J4
J5
J7 (A)
BLACK
BLACK
ORANGE
GRAY
B B
B
X X
DD DX
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
COMBINATION METER
J8 (B)
J11
GRAY
A
A
A
J16
BLACK
B B
B
A
A
J15
BLACK
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
C C C
D D D E E E
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J24
J28
J29
A
A A
B B B B
J21
GRAY
A A A
A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J30
O1
P1
GRAY
GRAY
GRAY
A A A A A A
1
X
5
6
P3
(Hint : See Page 7)
V2
W1
W3
W3
BLACK
BLACK
(1MZ–FE) DARK GRAY
(5S–FE) GRAY
1
1
1 2 3
1
2
R7
BLACK
1
1 2 3
MEMO
RADIATOR FAN AND CONDENSER FAN
ACC
2 AM1
1
1
IG1 4
30A
RDI
30A
CDS
W
2
B–Y
2
I16
IGNITION SW
1
4
FAN
NO. 1
RELAY
1 1K
2 1K
2
40A
AM1
15A
ECU–IG
1 2C
2
3
2 2F
1 2G
7 2G
2 2C
2 2H
W–B
W–B
EB
W–B
A1
A/C CONDENSER
FAN MOTOR
R
L
B–W
FAN NO. 2 RELAY
(1MZ–FE)
L
E4
5
2
1
3
4
1
5
1
B–R
W–R
B–R
W–B
(5S–FE)
* 1 : AUTOMATIC A/C
* 2 : MANUAL A/C
1
1
W–B
1
(1MZ–FE)
A34 B
2 EA1
BATTERY
3
1
(1MZ–FE)
L
W5
WATER
TEMP. SW NO. 2
A12 A
ENGINE CONTROL
MODULE
1
FAN
NO. 3
RELAY
1
2 B (*1)
12 A (*2)
MGC
E11 E
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
(1MZ–FE)
L–Y
1
1
II1
A/C CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
CF
A/C AMPLIFIER
29 E
W–B
B–G
F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
1
IK1
1
W4
WATER TEMP.
SW NO. 1
2
F4 A , F7 D ,
5
2
L–W
G–W
1 A
7 IK2
1
II2
(1MZ–FE)
1
(1MZ–FE)
L–Y
A3
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
2
1 EA1
100A
ALT
1
L
W–B
1 D
M
1
D3
DIODE
(A/C)
L–W
2 F
13 2J
G–W
B–R
W–B
B–R
1 F
3
(1MZ–FE)
B–R
4 2F
2
(1MZ–FE)
3
2 2B
B–R
E3
2
(1MZ–FE)
G–W
ENGINE
MAIN
RELAY
1
1
5
4
R1
RADIATOR
FAN MOTOR
G–W
M
(5S–FE)
B–R
2
6 2K
2
L
6 1A
1 1B
FROM MG CLT
RELAY
B–R
L
1
B–R
G–W
SYSTEM OUTLINE
FAN MOTOR OPERATION (1MZ–FE)
With the ignition SW turned on, the current through the ECU–IG fuse flows to the FAN NO.1 relay (Coil side), FAN NO.2 relay
(Coil side) and FAN NO.3 relay (Coil side). Furthermore, the current through the FAN NO.1 relay (Coil side) or the FAN NO.2
relay (Coil side) flows to TERMINAL 3 of the A/C single pressure SW to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 2 of the water temp. SW
No.1 to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND, causing the FAN NO.1 relay to turn off and the FAN NO.2 relay to turn on.
1. LOW SPEED OPERATION
Only when the A/C system is activated or the water temp. SW No.2 is turned on, the A/C condenser fan motor and the
radiator fan motor rotates at low speed.
When the A/C system is activated, the current from ECU–IG fuse flows to the FAN NO.3 relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL 1 of
the diode (A/C) to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL (A)12 of the A/C amplifier (Manual A/C) or (B) 2 of the A/C control assembly
(Automatic A/C) causing the FAN NO.3 relay to turn on. As a result, the current through the CDS fuse flows to TERMINAL 2
of the A/C condenser fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 3 of the FAN NO.2 relay to TERMINAL 5 to TERMINAL 5 of
the FAN NO.3 relay to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL 2 of the radiator fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND. As this flowing in
series for the motors, the motors rotate at low speed.
When the water temp. SW No.2 is turned on, the current from ECU–IG fuse flows to the FAN NO.3 relay (Coil side) to
TERMINAL 1 of the water temp. SW No.2 to GROUND, causing the FAN NO.3 relay to turn on. As a result, the current
through the CDS fuse flows the same route as above, rotating the motors at low speed.
2. HIGH SPEED OPERATION
Only when the A/C single pressure SW is turned off or the water temp. SW No.1 is turned off, the A/C condenser fan motor
and the radiator fan motor rotate at high speed.
When the A/C single pressure SW is turned off, the current from the RDI fuse flows to the FAN NO.1 relay (Point side) to
TERMINAL 2 of the radiator fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND. At the same time, the current from the CDS fuse flows
to TERMINAL 2 of the A/C condenser fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 3 of the FAN NO.2 relay to TERMINAL 4 to
GROUND.
As the current flowing in parallel for the motors as above, the motors rotate at high speed.
FAN MOTOR OPERATION (5S–FE)
With the ignition SW turned on, the current through the ECU–IG fuse flows to the FAN NO.1 relay (Coil side), FAN NO.2 relay
(Coil side). furthermore, the current through the FAN NO.1 relay (Coil side) or the FAN NO.2 relay (Coil side) flows to
TERMINAL 3 of the A/C single pressure SW to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 2 of the water temp. SW No.1 to TERMINAL 1 to
GROUND, causing the FAN NO.1 relay to turn off and the FAN NO.2 relay to turn on.
1. LOW SPEED OPERATION
When the ignition SW is turned on and the A/C system is activated, the A/C condenser fan motor and the radiator fan motor
rotates at low speed.
When the A/C system is activated, the current from MG CLT relay flows to the FAN NO.3 relay (Coil side) to GROUND,
causing the FAN NO.3 relay to turn on. As a result, the current through the CDS fuse flows to TERMINAL 2 of the A/C
condenser fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 3 of the FAN NO.2 relay to TERMINAL 5 to TERMINAL 5 of the FAN
NO.3 relay to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL 2 of the radiator fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND. As this flowing in series
for the motors, the motors rotate at low speed.
2. HIGH SPEED OPERATION
Only when the A/C single pressure SW is turned off or the water temp. SW No.1 is turned off, the A/C condenser fan motor
and the radiator fan motor rotate at high speed.
When the A/C single pressure SW is turned off, the current from the RDI fuse flows to the FAN NO.1 relay (Point side) to
TERMINAL 2 of the radiator fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND. At the same time, the current from the CDS fuse flows
to TERMINAL 2 of the A/C condenser fan motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 3 of the FAN NO.2 relay to TERMINAL 4 to
GROUND.
As the current flowing in parallel for the motors as above, the motors rotate at high speed.
SERVICE HINTS
A3 A/C SINGLE PRESSURE SW
3–2 : Open above approx. 15.5 kgf/cm2 (224 psi, 1520 kpa)
Closed below approx. 12.5 kgf/cm2 (181 psi, 1225 kpa)
W4 WATER TEMP. SW NO.1
2–1 : Open above approx. 95°C (203° F)
W5 WATER TEMP. SW NO.2 (1MZ–FE)
1–GROUND : Closed above approx. 90°C (194°F)
RADIATOR FAN AND CONDENSER FAN
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
26 (1MZ–FE)
A1
28 (5S–FE)
26 (1MZ–FE)
A3
28 (5S–FE)
A12
A
30
A34
B
30
D3
Code
E
F4
A
F7
F9
26 (1MZ–FE)
See Page
E11
D
F
Code
30
I16
26 (1MZ–FE)
R1
28 (5S–FE)
26 (1MZ–FE)
W4
28 (5S–FE)
26 (1MZ–FE)
W5
See Page
30
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
27 (1MZ–FE)
29 (5S–FE)
27 (1MZ–FE)
28 (5S–FE)
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
1
See Page
24
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1A
1B
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
22
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Engine
g
Room J/B No.2 ((Engine
g
Compartment Left))
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1K
2B
2C
2F
2G
2H
2J
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
EA1
II1
II2
IK1
IK2
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room Main No
No.3
3 Wire (Radiator LH)
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
EB
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Ground Points Location
Left Radiator Side Support
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E3
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
Code
E4
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Engine Room Main Wire
∗ 1 : 1MZ–FE Except California
A1
A3
A12 (A)
GRAY
BLACK
ORANGE
2
1
2
A34 (B)
X
X
X 12
2 X
3
X X X X
D3
E11 (E)
E11 (E)
ORANGE
(∗ 1) BLACK
(1MZ–FE California)
F4 (A)
1
1 2
X
X
X
X
F7 (D)
29
F9 (F)
I16
ORANGE
29
R1
W4
GRAY
(1MZ–FE) GRAY
1
1
W4
W5
(5S–FE)
GRAY
1 2
1
1 2
2
X
2
4
X
1
2
AIR CONDITIONING (AUTOMATIC A/C)
50A HTR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
F8
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
10A
HEATER
10A
ECU–B
1
7 2J
W–R
3 1R
L–B
L–B
2 1W
L–B
L–B
5 2K
1
1
1
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
1
10 1V
W–R
L–B
3 1W
A
5
1
HTR
RELAY
2
1
A
MG CLT
RELAY
3
1
9 2C
W–R
2
1
3
1
L–B
L–B
4
5
L–B
1
1
L–W
L–R
W–B
B–W
L–W
L–W
L–W
L–R
1 EB2
2
1
M
B–W
I8
B–W
3
+B
B–W
VM
SI
2
B–W
A33
A/C BLOWER MOTOR
LINEAR CONTROLLER
4
GND
6
W–B
1
2
W–B
L–R
B8
BLOWER RESISTOR
(LOW SPEED)
I7
B–W
L–R
B3
BLOWER MOTOR
W–B
I7
W–B
B–W
W–B
L–B
A
A
A
W–B
W–B
W–B
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
EB
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
A
II
IG
W–B
Y–G
FROM DEFOGGER RELAY
23 A
RDFG
A34 A , A35 B
A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
FOOT
F/D
DEF
18 A
19 A
20 A
L–O
5
B/L
17 A
B–L
7
FACE
4 A
TO SPEEDOMETER
[COMB. METER]
L
L
L–B
W–L
L–B
11 IK2
2 EB1 9 IK2
L–Y
7 IK2
L–B
L–Y
V–W
6
SPD
15 A
L–R
TPI
7 B
L
AIR
7 A
L–W
AIF
6 A
P–L
PSW
9 B
R
BLW
16 B
L–Y
LOCK
3 A
B–W
HR
10 A
W–L
MGCR
2 B
L–W
L–B
IG+
26 A
W–R
B
13 A
D3
DIODE (A/C)
2
3
3
W–R
M
L–W
L–W
1
W–R
1
A3
A/C DUAL
PRESSURE
SW
2
A20
AIR VENT MODE
CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
L–O
B–L
L–R
L
1
2
3
4
5
FACE
B/L
FOOT
F/D
DEF
4
M
W–B
4
W–R
A2
A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AND LOCK SENSOR
1
L–W
L–B
B–W
B–W
W–L
A38
AIR INLET CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
B–W
A
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
B
W–B
L–B
L–B
6 IG
W–B
W–B
7 GND
W–R
W–B
W–B
AIR CONDITIONING (AUTOMATIC A/C)
A34 A , A35 B
A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
2
1
A30
A/C AMBIENT TEMP. SENSOR
2
D B
I10
F A
B–Y
4
3
F
F
WARM
W–R
I9
COOL
10
IK2
W–R
A39
AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
W–B
W–B
B–Y
LG–B
V
25
13
14
TACH
A/C
ACT
THWO
E8
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
5
W–R
V
B–O
27
W–R
F
W–R
L
1
F
W–R
P
2
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
J1
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–R
W–R
W–R
A
GND
14 A
IK3
L
A
A
M
TW
14 B
L
L
4
LG–B
B–Y
B–O
Y
1
2 IG1
ACT
10 B
IK1
Y
1
AC1
13 B
J27 A , J28 B
W–R
IGN
16 A
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
W–R
TAM
3 B
W–R
1
A13
A/C EVAPORATOR TEMP. SENSOR
W–R
2
L
1
A37
A/C SOLAR SENSOR
2
A36
A/C ROOM TEMP. SENSOR
W–R
W
1 IG1
L
TE
6 B
L–W
TR
4 B
G–Y
SG
1 A
W–R
TS
5 B
W
B–Y
TP
8 B
L
S5
11 A
P
AMC
8 A
G–R
AMH
9 A
SYSTEM OUTLINE
1. HEATER BLOWER MOTOR OPERATION
Current is applied at all times through HTR fuse to TERMINAL 1 of the HTR relay. When the ignition SW is turned on,
current flows through the HEATER fuse to TERMINAL 5 of the HTR relay to TERMINAL 3 to TERMINAL HR of the A/C
control assembly. At the same time, current also flows from HEATER fuse to TERMINAL IG+ of the A/C control assembly.
∗ Low speed operation
When the blower SW (A/C control assembly) is pushed to LOW SPEED position, the current to TERMINAL HR of the
A/C control assembly flows to TERMINAL GND of the A/C control assembly to GROUND and turns the HTR relay on.
As a result, the current to TERMINAL 1 of the HTR relay flows to TERMINAL 2 of the relay to TERMINAL 2 of the
blower motor to TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 2 of the blower resistor to TERMINAL 6 to GROUND and causes the
blower motor to rotate at low speed.
∗ High speed operation
When the blower SW (A/C control assembly) is pushed to HIGH SPEED position, the current to TERMINAL HR of the
A/C control assembly flows to TERMINAL GND of the A/C control assembly to GROUND and turns the HTR relay on.
As a result, the current to TERMINAL 1 of the HTR relay flows to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 2 of the blower motor to
TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL 4 of the A/C blower motor linear controller to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL BLW of the A/C
control assembly (Which is activated when the blower SW is pushed to high speed position) to TERMINAL GND to
GROUND without passing through the blower resistor, causing the blower motor to rotate at high speed.
2. AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR OPERATION
(Switching from FRESH to RECIRC)
With the ignition SW turned on, the current flows from HEATER fuse to TERMINAL IG+ of the A/C control assembly to
TERMINAL AIR to TERMINAL 7 of the air inlet control servo motor to TERMINAL 6 to TERMINAL AIF of the A/C control
assembly to TERMINAL GND to GROUND, the motor rotates and the damper moves to the RECIRC side. when the
damper operates with the A/C SW at RECIRC position, the damper position signal is input from TERMINAL 5 of the servo
motor to TERMINAL TPI of the A/C control assembly. As a result, current to the servo motor circuit is cut off by the A/C
control assembly, so the damper stops at that position.
(Switching from RECIRC to FRESH)
With the ignition SW turned on, when the RECIRC/FRESH SW is switched to the FRESH side, the current flows from
TERMINAL IG+ of the A/C control assembly to TERMINAL AIF to TERMINAL 6 of the air inlet control servo motor to
TERMINAL 7 to TERMINAL AIR of the A/C control assembly to TERMINAL GND to GROUND, The motor rotates and the
damper stops at that position.
3. AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR OPERATION
When the ignition SW turned on, the current flows from HEATER fuse to TERMINAL IG+ of the A/C control assembly.
(Switching from DEF to FACE)
The current flows from TERMINAL FACE of the A/C control assembly to TERMINAL 1 of the air vent mode control servo
motor to TERMINAL 5 to TERMINAL DEF of the A/C control assembly to TERMINAL GND to GROUND. The motor rotates
and the damper moves to the FACE side. When the damper operates with the A/C SW at FACE position, the damper
position signal is input from TERMINAL 5 of the servo motor to the TERMINAL DEF of the A/C control assembly. As a
result, current to the servo motor circuit is cut off by the A/C control assembly, so the damper stops at that position.
(Switching from FACE to DEF)
The current flows from TERMINAL DEF of the A/C control assembly to TERMINAL 5 of the air vent control servo motor to
TERMINAL 1 to TERMINAL FACE of the A/C control assembly to TERMINAL GND to GROUND, the motor rotates and the
damper stops at that position.
4. AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR OPERATION
When the temperature control SW (A/C control assembly) is turned to the ”COOL” side the current flows from TERMINAL
AMC of the A/C control assembly to TERMINAL 1 of the air mix control servo motor to motor to TERMINAL 2 to
TERMINAL AMH of the A/C control assembly to GROUND and the motor rotates. The damper opening angle at this time
is input from TERMINAL 3 of the servo motor to TERMINAL TP of the A/C control assembly, this is used to determine the
DAMPER STOP position and maintain the set temperature.
When the temperature control SW (A/C control assembly) is turned to the ”HOT” side, the current flows from servo motor
to TERMINAL AMH of the A/C control assembly to TERMINAL 2 of the air mix control servo motor to motor to TERMINAL
1 to TERMINAL AMC of the A/C control assembly, rotating the motor in reverse and switching the damper from ”COOL” to
”HOT” side.
AIR CONDITIONING (AUTOMATIC A/C)
5. AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
The A/C control assembly receives various signals, I.E., the engine RPM from the engine control module, out side air
temperature signal from the A/C ambient temp. sensor, coolant temperature from the engine control module and the lock
signal from the A/C compressor, etc.
When the engine is started and the A/C SW (A/C control assembly) is on, a signal is input to the A/C control assembly.
As a result, the ground circuit in A/C control assembly is closed and current flows from HEATER fuse to TERMINAL 1 of
the MG CLT relay to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL 3 of the diode (A/C) to TERMINAL 2 to TERMINAL MGCR of the A/C
control assembly to TERMINAL GND to GROUND, turning the MG CLT relay on, so that the magnetic clutch is on and the
A/C compressor operates.
At the same time, the engine control module. Detects the magnetic clutch is on and the A/C compressor operates.
If the A/C control assembly detects the following conditions, it stops the air conditioning:
∗ Evaporator outlet air is too low.
∗ There is a marked difference between the compressor speed and the engine speed.
∗ The refrigerant pressure is abnormally high or abnormally low.
∗ The engine speed is too low.
∗ Rapid acceleration occurs.
SERVICE HINTS
A3 A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
4–1 : Open above approx. 2.0 kgf/cm2 (29 psi, 196 kpa) or 32 kgf/cm2 (464 psi, 3138 kpa)
A2 A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH AND LOCK SENSOR
4–GROUND : Approx. 3.7 Ω
A34 (A), A35 (B) A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
B–GROUND : Always approx. 12 volts
IG+ –GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
HR –GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the ignition SW at ON position and do not turn the blower motor
Below 1 volts with the ignition SW at ON position and turn the blower motor
PSW–GROUND : Below 1 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
AC1–GROUND : Below 1 volts at start the engine, operate the compressor
+ OR MORE volts at start the engine, do not operate the compressor
BLW–GROUND : Below 1.5 volts with the ignition SW on and turn the blower motor
S5–SG : 4–6 volts with the ignition SW at ON position
SG–GROUND : Always continuity
AMH–AMC : 1.3–1.9 volts with the ignition SW off
AIF–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the FRESH SW on
AIR–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the RECIRC SW on
FACE–GROUND: Approx. 12 volts with the FACE SW on
DEF–GROUND : Approx. 12 volts with the DEF SW on
GND–GROUND : Always continuity
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
A2
26 (1MZ–FE)
A36
30
F8
26 (1MZ–FE)
A3
26 (1MZ–FE)
A37
30
J1
31
A13
30
A38
30
A20
30
A39
30
J27
A
31
A30
26 (1MZ–FE)
B3
30
J28
B
31
A33
30
B8
30
J29
31
J32
31
A34
A
30
D3
30
A35
B
30
E8
30
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
1
See Page
24
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
J11
31
,,,
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
,,,
,,,
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1R
1V
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower
(
Finish Panel))
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1W
2C
2J
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
EB2
36 (1MZ–FE)
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
IG1
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Cowl Wire (Lower Finish Panel)
42
Engine
g
Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire ((Right
g Kick Panel))
IK1
IK2
IK3
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
EB
36 (1MZ–FE)
Left Radiator Side Support
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
II
40
Cowl Side Panel RH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
See Page
I7
42
I8
Wire Harness with Splice Points
A2
A3
BLACK
1
4
See Page
I9
Cowl Wire
GRAY
1 2
X 4
Code
42
I10
A13
Cowl Wire
A20
A30
DARK GRAY
1 2
A33
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
A34 (A)
1 2
A35 (B)
BLACK
1
2
3
4
Wire Harness with Splice Points
1 3 4 X 6 7 8 9 10 11 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 X X 23 X X 26
A36
A37
BLACK
BLACK
X 2 3 4
5 6
12
1 2
7
8 9 10 X
X 13 14 X 16
A38
A39
B3
B8
D3
BLACK
1 X 3 X 5 6 7
ORANGE
X
1
2 3 4 5
1
2
X
2
X
X
6
2 3
AIR CONDITIONING (AUTOMATIC A/C)
E8
F8
J1
1
X X X
X
X 13 14 X X X X
X
A A
A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J11
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
X 25 X 27 X
J27 (A)
J28 (B)
J29
J32
GRAY
F F
D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
F F F F
A A
A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
MEMO
AIR CONDITIONING (MANUAL A/C)
50A HTR
FROM POWER SOURCE SYSTEM (SEE PAGE 50)
F8
FUSIBLE
LINK BLOCK
10A
HEATER
2 1W
3 1R
L–B
L–B
1
5 2K
A
1
5
1
4
HTR
RELAY
2
5
MG CLT
RELAY
A
1
3
1
L–B
1
L–W
L–R
L–R
B–W
W–B
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
9 2C
2
3
1
1
L–B
1
1
L–B
1
1
L–B
L–B
L–B
L–B
L–B
B–W
L–Y(* 2)
L–Y(* 2)
L–W(* 1)
L–W(* 1)
B–W(*2)
TO FAN NO. 3 RELAY
10A A/C
1
1
L–R
B4
BLOWER RESISTOR
2
M
3
EB1
L–R
1
2 EB1
L–R
1 EB2
2
3
B3
BLOWER
MOTOR
2
6
W–B
1
(* 1)
LO
(* 1)
L–B
4
M1
W–B
8
M2
W–B
5
HI
W–B
L–W
B–W
I3
L–O
B–W
L–B
B–W
1
W–B
W–B
OFF
3
A
1
B5
BLOWER SW
W–B
A
A
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
L–B
EB
A
IG
W–B
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
H9
HEATER CONTROL SW
L–B
B–W
FACE
B/L
FOOT
F/D
DEF
3
GND
FACE
B/L
FOOT
F/D
DEF
1
8
7
6
5
4
2
L–B
B–W
L–Y(*2)
L–Y(* 1)
L–W(* 1)
3
2
7
IK2
L–Y
L–O
B–L
L–R
L
L–W
L–R
R–B
W–B
(*1)
L–Y(* 2)
D3
DIODE
(A/C)
D
L–R
D
D
L–R
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
W–B
(*1)
(* 1)
R–W
1
2
3
4
5
FACE
B/L
FOOT
F/D
DEF
(* 1)
R–B
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
5
(* 2)
1
A
B
L–B
6 IG
OFF
W–B
7 GND
ON
A20
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
R–W
(* 1)
2
R–W
R–B
M
L–R
R–B
A14
A/C SW
AIR CONDITIONING (MANUAL A/C)
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
* 3 : 5S–FE W/ ENGINE IMMOBILISER
* 4 : 5S–FE W/O ENGINE IMMOBILISER
L–B
B–W
B–W
1
A2
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
4
A3
A/C DUAL
PRESSURE SW
1
2
W–R(*1)
9 IK2
10 IK2
W–R(*1)
IK2
G
BR(* 2)
W–L
2
W–L
G
4
(* 2)
TH
BR(* 2)
(*2)
(*1)
J29
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B
BR
(* 2)
(*2)
W–R
J8
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
10
II3
6
II3
(* 2)
II2
J23
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
BR
BR
3
F
2
BR
(* 2)
II2
L–R
(* 1)
B–O
(* 2)
R–B
(* 2)
L–Y
G
(* 2)
1
F
B
BR
(* 2)
F
1
(* 2)
R–W
A13
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
(* 2)
F A
L–W
B
(* 1)
R–B
LG–B
B
R–B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B
J27 A , J28 B
J12
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
(* 1)
W–R
13
(* 1)
D B
SG
9
(* 2)
ACT
7
W–L
AC1
1
W–B
R–W
(* 1)
W–L
IGN
4
L–W
(*1)
(*1)
R–B
8
(*1)
S–A/C
B–Y
10
LOCK
(*1)
L–A/C
5
R–W
GND
(*1)
14
+B
B–O
MGC
W–B
A12
A/C AMPLIFIER
2
(*1)
12
(* 1)
G
L–Y(* 2)
(*1)
L–Y(* 1)
A
20 A
15 A
LOCK
19 A
13 A
PRS
21 A
21 A
MGC
25 B
13 B
10 A
10 A
A/C SW
11 B
10 B
TACH
A/C
E7 A , E8 B , E9 C
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
ACT
THR
9 B
9 B
E2
(*1)
19 C (*3)
18 C (*4)
LOCK IN
A
(* 2)
27 B
EC
SYSTEM OUTLINE
Current always flows from the HTR fuse to TERMINAL 1 of the HTR relay. When the ignition SW is turned on, the current
from the HEATER fuse flows to TERMINAL 6 of the air vent mode control servo motor, to the MG CLT relay (Coil side) to
TERMINAL MGC of the A/C amplifier (1MZ–FE) or TERMINAL MGC of the engine control module (5S–FE), to TERMINAL 1
of the A/C dual pressure SW to TERMINAL 4 to TERMINAL +B of the A/C amplifier (1MZ–FE) or TERMINAL PRS of the
engine control module (5S–FE), current also to the HTR relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL 3 of the blower SW.
1. AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR OPERATION
When the damper is in FACE position and B/L mode on the heater control SW is selected, current flows from TERMINAL 7
of the heater control SW to TERMINAL 2 of the air vent mode control serve motor so that a signal that the ground circuit is
activated is input into TERMINAL B of the control circuit inside the air vent mode control servo motor. Simultaneously, a
signal that the ground circuit is not activated is input into TERMINAL A of the control circuit inside the servo motor. These two
signals activate the control circuit so that current flows from the HEATER fuse to the servo motor, causing the servo motor to
operate and the damper to move to B/L position. When the damper reaches B/L position. A ground cut signal is input into
TERMINAL B of the control circuit, the control circuit operates, the servo motor stops rotating and the damper stops at B/L.
When another mode position is selected, input of signals into TERMINAL A and TERMINAL B of the control circuit that
ground is made or not (as explained above) activates the control circuit and moves the serve motor to the desired position.
2. AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
When the blower SW is on, current flows from the HEATER fuse to the HTR relay (Coil side) to TERMINAL 3 of the blower
SW to TERMINAL 1 to GROUND, activating the HTR relay. This causes current to flow from the HTR fuse to the HTR relay
(Point side) to A/C fuse to TERMINAL 2 of the A/C SW. If the A/C SW is turned on at this time, a signal is input into the A/C
amplifier (1MZ–FE) or engine control module (5S–FE). This activates the A/C amplifier (1MZ–FE) or engine control module
(5S–FE) and MG CLT relay so that current flows from the HEATER fuse to the MG CLT relay (Point side) to A/C magnetic
clutch. Causing The compressor to operate.
When blower SW is on and heater control SW is at DEF position, it causes A/C to run whether A/C SW is on or not.
SERVICE HINTS
HTR RELAY [R/B NO.1]
1–2 : Closed with the ignition SW on and the blower SW on
MG CLT RELAY [R/B NO.1]
5–3 : Closed with the ignition SW on, the blower SW on and the A/C SW on or the heater control SW at DEF position
A3 A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
1–4 : Open with pressure 2.0 kgf/cm2 (29 psi, 196 kpa) or above 32 kgf/cm2 (464 psi, 3138 kpa)
B4 BLOWER RESISTOR
6–1 : Approx. 0.62 Ω
1–3 : Approx. 1.46 Ω
2–6 : Approx. 0.38 Ω
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
A2
A3
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
26 (1MZ–FE)
B4
30
J8
31
28 (5S–FE)
B5
30
J11
31
26 (1MZ–FE)
D3
26 (1MZ–FE)
J12
31
J23
28 (5S–FE)
E7
A
30
A12
30
E8
B
30
J27
A
31
A13
30
E9
C
30
J28
B
31
A14
30
A20
30
B3
30
F8
H9
26 (1MZ–FE)
J29
31
28 (5S–FE)
J32
31
30
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
1
See Page
24
31
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Compartment Left)
AIR CONDITIONING (MANUAL A/C)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
1R
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
2C
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
2K
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No.2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1W
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
See Page
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
36 (1MZ–FE)
EB1
38 (5S–FE)
Cowl Wire and Engine Room Main Wire (Under the Engine Room J/B No.2)
No 2)
36 (1MZ–FE)
EB2
38 (5S–FE)
II2
II3
IK2
42
Engine Wire and Cowl Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
Ground Points Location
36 (1MZ–FE)
EB
Left Radiator Side Support
38 (5S–FE)
EC
38 (5S–FE)
Intake Manifold
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
I3
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
42
Code
A2
A3
A12
GRAY
BLACK
ORANGE
1 2
X 4
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Cowl Wire
1
4
A20
A13
1 2 X
4 5 X
7 8 9 10 X 1213 14
B3
A14
1 25
1 2
B4
B5
D3
ORANGE
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1
2
3
2
X
X
6
1
4
X 3
5
8
2 3
E7 (A)
E7 (A)
E8 (B)
(∗ 1)
(∗ 2)
(1MZ–FE)
10
X 10
19 20 21
13 15 21
X X X
∗ 1 : 5S–FE w/ Engine Immobiliser System
∗ 2 : 5S–FE w/o Engine Immobiliser System
X
X 13 X X X X
X
E8 (B)
X 25 X 27 X
E9 (C)
(∗ 1) DARK GRAY
E8 (B)
(∗ 2)
X
9 11
9 10 X
X X 19
(∗ 1) DARK GRAY
E9 (C)
F8
H9
J8
(∗ 2)
GRAY
12
3
456 7 8
1
X 18
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
J11
J12
J23
J27(A)
BLACK
A
A
A
A
A
B B
DD DB
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
F F
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J28 (B)
D D
(Hint : See Page 7)
J29
F F F F
J32
GRAY
A A
A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
I GROUND POINT
W–B
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT AND PARKING
LIGHT LH
W–B
W–B
W–B
E1
E4
W–B
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
LIGHT AND PARKING
LIGHT RH
W–B
WASHER LEVEL
WARNING SW
W–B
E4
E1
W–B
W–B
2
EA1
E4
FAN NO. 3 RELAY
1
HTR RELAY
1
DRL NO. 4 RELAY
2
E4
E1
W–B
E4
W–B
ABS AND
TRACTION
ECU
(GND3)
(* 3)
W–B
ABS AND
TRACTION
ACTUATOR
(* 3)
W–B
(GND1)
(*2 * 4)
W–B
(GND2)
(*2 * 4)
W–B
ABS
ACTUATOR
AND ECU
ABS ACTUATOR
(* 1)
W–B
(CALIFORNIA)
2
A/F HTR RELAY
W–B
(5S–FE)
(GND2)
(* 3)
W–B
1
E1
W–B
W–B
FAN NO. 2 RELAY
W–B
W–B
W–B
E1
W–B
E4
W–B
(GND1)
(* 3)
E4
W–B
WATER TEMP. SW
NO. 1
W–B
ABS SOL RELAY
W–B
RADIATOR FAN
MOTOR
E1
W–B
ENGINE HOOD
COURTESY SW
W–B
3
(*1, * 3)
W–B
W–B
E4
E4
(* 5)
W–B
(* 5)
W–B
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
W–B
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RESISTOR
W–B
EFI RELAY
W–B
10
2J
4
2F
W–B
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
W–B
5 2C
(AUTOMATIC A/C)
W–B
W–B
EB
EA
A/C DUAL PRESSURE
SW
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
BR
A
A BR
2
II1
6
II3
BR
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
BR
BR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
B
B
C
A
BR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
B
B
C
A
BR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3 (SG)
J7 A ,
J8 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
(EOM)
BR
A
BR
I2
A
BR
A
BR
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
(E1)
BR
(ADJ2)
(* 2 M/T)
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 2 SENSOR 1)
J26
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
A
BR
I2
BR
(CALIFORNIA)
B
BR
BR
(CALIFORNIA)
BR
(E05)
ENGINE
CONTROL
MODULE
(E04)
(E03)
BR
(E02)
BR
(E01)
BR
IGNITER
(1MZ–FE)
ED
COMBINATION
METER
(EXCEPT CALIFORNIA)
BR
NOISE FILTER
(IGNITION)
B
(CALIFORNIA)
BR
(ET)
BR
3
IJ1
BR
BR
COMBINATION
METER
BR
(CALIFORNIA)
(ET)
EC
(1MZ–FE)
3
IJ1
BR
*
*
*
*
*
1 : TMC MADE
2 : TMMK MADE
3 : W/ TRACTION CONTROL
4 : W/O TRACTION CONTROL
5 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
BR
(E04)
(CALIFORNIA)
(EOM)
A
(E01)
BR
(CALIFORNIA)
A
(E1)
BR
BR
BR
IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER NO. 2
BR
BR
IGNITION COIL AND
IGNITER NO. 1
A
J19
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BR
ENGINE
CONTROL
MODULE
(E02)
BR
(E03)
BR
(5S–FE)
BR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
BR
A
A
A
A
A
BR
BR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
(SG)
BR
C
A
BR
J7 A ,
J8 B
B
B
BR
6
II3
B
B
BR
10
IK2
I2
BR
(EXCEPT
CALIFORNIA)
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
BR
J23
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
A
(5S–FE)
BR
BR
EC
BR
EC
12
II2
BR
BR
HEATED OXYGEN
SENSOR
(BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
I GROUND POINT
CRUISE CONTROL
ECU
TRACTION OFF SW
A
B
A
A
W–B
CRUISE CONTROL
ACTUATOR
W–B
A
B
A
A
W–B
CRUISE CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
A
B
A
A
W–B
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
A
A
W–B
LIGHT CONTROL AND
DIMMER SW
[COMB. SW]
A
A
W–B
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
(* 3)
(CG)
POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW AND
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW LH
(E)
(E)
W–B
W–B(*1)
A
W–B
A
(* 1)
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
FRONT LH
W–B
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
W–B
A
(* 1)
A
(* 1)
A
W–B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH
POWER WINDOW
MASTER SW AND
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW LH
J38
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
W–B
A
A
J7 A ,
(E)
W–B
W–B
UNLOCK WARNING SW
J8 B
W–B
(E1) CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
8 1J
(* 1)
(E)
(* 5)
3 1M
1 1N
W–B(*2)
POWER RELAY
W–B
W–B
(*1)
(* 2)
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
FRONT LH
W–B
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT LH
W–B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH
W–B
INTEGRATION RELAY
W–B
B13
(* 2)
NOISE FILTER
(* 2)
20 IE1
W–B
W–B
(* 6)
(* 6)
W–B
W–B
9
2K
B2
W–B(*6)
(*9)
W–B
I7
(* 9)
A
B3
W–B
W–B
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
TRANSPONDER KEY
AMPLIFIER
W–B
A/C CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
W–B
W–B
(MANUAL A/C)
I1
A
(* 9)
W–B
W–B
W–B
(1MZ–FE MANUAL A/C)
W–B
A
W–B
W–B
W–B(*1)
A
W–B
(* 1)
BM
(* 9)
(MANUAL A/C)
B2
A/C AMPLIFIER
W–B
(MANUAL A/C)
W–B
(*1 * 6)
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
WARNING SW
W–B
W–B
MOON ROOF MOTOR
AND LIMIT SW
ST RELAY
W–B
3 1V
B2
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
W–B
W–B
PERSONAL LIGHT
W–B
W–B
3
1F
W–B
WIPER AND WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
W–B
W–B
A
4
1V
W–B
W–B
MOON ROOF CONTROL
SW AND RELAY
W–B
W–B
VANITY LIGHT RH
A
B 3 : *6
B 2 : *7
VANITY LIGHT LH
(E2)
7 1G
3
1N
W–B
POWER OUTLET
(* 2)
W–B
W–B
CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
NOISE FILTER
7 1J
(* 2)
IE
II
IG
BLOWER RESISTOR
(LOW SPEED)
A/C BLOWER MOTOR
LINEAR CONTROLLER
HEATER CONTROL SW
BLOWER RESISTOR
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
BLOWER SW
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
AIR VENT MODE
CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(GND)
ABS ECU
(GND2)
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR SW
O/D MAIN SW
SHIFT LOCK ECU
A
A
W–B
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK
ECU
W–B
A
A
W–B
THEFT DETERRENT
ECU
W–B
A
A
W–B
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
(* 1)
(–)
COMBINATION
METER
W–B
(EP)
CLOCK
W–B
A
W–B
A
W–B
A
A
J39
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
FRONT RH
W–B
(* 1)
A
W–B
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
(* 1)
W–B
GLOVE BOX LIGHT
AND SW
A
A
W–B
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH
(* 1)
W–B
RHEOSTAT
A
A
W–B
(*2)
RADIO AND PLAYER
(*2)
W–B
W–B
(*2)
W–B
(*2)
IF
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
FRONT RH
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SW RH
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH
IJ
7
IH1
1
IF2
BR
BR
BR
BR
W–B
B14
20 IM1
W–B
STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
W–B
(* 2)
W–B
1 : TMC MADE
2 : TMMK MADE
3 : W/ TRACTION CONTROL
5 : W/ DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT
6 : W/ MOON ROOF
7 : W/O MOON ROOF
8 : W/O THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
9 : AUTOMATIC A/C
W–B
A
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
DOOR KEY LOCK AND
UNLOCK SW FRONT RH
BR
BR
BR
FUEL SENDER
(ES)
COMBINATION
METER
IH
W–B
6
BP1
W–B
POWER SEAT
CONTROL SW
(FRONT PASSENGER’ S
SEAT)
W–B
1
BR1
W–B
W–B
B6
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR RH
IK
W–B
W–B
B6
BN
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR
AND RELAY
I GROUND POINT
BUCKLE SW LH
W–B
(*10)
B12
W–B
(* 10)
1
BQ1
W–B
A
A
W–B
B9
W–B
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT RH
W–B
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT LH
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
DOOR LOCK MOTOR
AND DOOR UNLOCK
DETECTION SW
REAR LH
W–B
W–B
(*10)
A
HIGH MOUNTED
STOP LIGHT
W–B
A
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT LH
W–B
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT RH
W–B
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
KEY UNLOCK SW
W–B
W–B
A
B9
W–B
B11
B9
W–B
W–B
FUEL PUMP
BUCKLE SW LH
(*11)
A
POWER SEAT CONTROL
SW
(DRIVER’ S SEAT)
W–B
(*10)
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
B11
W–B
B11
* 10 : W/ POWER SEAT
* 11 : W/O POWER SEAT
W–B
W–B
6
BO1
BL
B11
W–B
LIGHT FAILURE
SENSOR
A
B
BP
BO
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
: PARTS LOCATION
Code
See Page
J5
Code
See Page
Code
See Page
31
J19
31
J38
32
J7
A
31
J22
31
J39
32
J8
B
31
J23
31
J40
32
31
J26
31
J11
: RELAY BLOCKS
Code
See Page
Relay Blocks (Relay Block Location)
1
24
Engine Room R/B No.1 (Engine Comportment Left)
2
24
Engine Room R/B No.2 (Near The Battery)
3
25
Engine Room R/B No.3 (Radiator Upper Support RH)
: JUNCTION BLOCK AND WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
Code
See Page
Junction Block and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
1F
20
Roof Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
1G
20
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
20
Cowl Wire and Instrument Panel J/B (Lower Finish Panel)
22
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
22
Cowl Wire and Engine Room J/B No
No.2
2 (Engine Compartment Left)
1J
1M
1N
1V
2C
2F
2J
2K
: CONNECTOR JOINING WIRE HARNESS AND WIRE HARNESS
Code
EA1
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
38 (5S–FE)
Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness (Connector Location)
Engine Room Main Wire and Engine Room Main No
No.3
3 Wire (Radiator LH)
IE1
40
Front Door LH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IF2
40
Floor Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Left Kick Panel)
IH1
40
Instrument Panel Wire and Instrument Panel No.2 Wire (Instrument Panel Brace RH)
42
Engine
g
Wire and Cowl Wire (Under
(
the Blower Motor))
II1
II2
II3
IJ1
42
Engine Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Under the Blower Motor)
IK2
42
Engine Room Main Wire and Cowl Wire (Right Kick Panel)
IM1
42
Front Door RH Wire and Instrument Panel Wire (Right Kick Panel)
BO1
44
Rear Door Wire LH and Floor Wire (Under the Left Center Pillar)
BP1
44
Rear Door Wire RH and Floor No.2 Wire (Under the Right Center Pillar)
BQ1
46
Floor Wire and Seat No.1 Wire (Under the Driver’s Seat)
BR1
46
Floor No.2 Wire and Seat No.2 Wire (Under the Passenger’s Seat)
I GROUND POINT
: GROUND POINTS
Code
See Page
36 (1MZ–FE)
EA
38 (5S–FE)
36 (1MZ–FE)
EB
38 (5S–FE)
Ground Points Location
Right Radiator Side Support
Left Radiator Side Support
36 (1MZ–FE)
Surge Tank RH
38 (5S–FE)
Intake Manifold
ED
36 (1MZ–FE)
Rear Side of the Surge Tank
IE
40
Cowl Side Panel LH
IF
40
Left Kick Panel
IG
40
Instrument Panel Brace LH
IH
40
Instrument Panel Brace RH
II
40
Cowl Side Panel RH
40
Right Kick Panel
EC
IJ
IK
BL
44
Under the Left Center Pillar
BM
44
Roof Left
BN
44
Under the Right Center Pillar
BO
44
Right Quarter Pillar
BP
44
Back Panel Center
: SPLICE POINTS
Code
E1
E4
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
Code
See Page
Wire Harness with Splice Points
36 (1MZ–FE)
B3
44
Roof Wire
38 (5S–FE)
B6
44
Floor No.2 Wire
44
Floor Wire
36 (1MZ–FE)
Engine Room Main Wire
38 (5S–FE)
B9
B11
I1
42
Cowl Wire
B12
46
Seat No.1 Wire
I2
42
Engine Wire
B13
44
Front Door LH Wire
I7
42
Cowl Wire
B14
44
Front Door RH Wire
B2
44
Roof Wire
J5
J7 (A)
J8 (B)
ORANGE
GRAY
GRAY
A A A
A A
A A A A A A A A
A A A A A A
A A A A A A
C C C
B B B
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J19
J11
(Hint : See Page 7)
J22
J23
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
A A
A A
A A A A A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J26
GRAY
A A A
A A A
(Hint : See Page 7)
B
B B B
(Hint : See Page 7)
J38
J39
A A A
A A A
A A A
X X
A A A X X X X
(Hint : See Page 7)
(Hint : See Page 7)
J40
A
A
A
A
A
A
(Hint : See Page 7)
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
[A] : System Title
[B] : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B
= Black
W = White
BR = Brown
L
= Blue
V
SB = Sky Blue
= Violet
R = Red
O = Orange LG = Light Green
P
Y
= Pink
= Yellow
[F] : Junction Block (The number in the circle is the
J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Blocks are shaded to clearly
separate them from other parts.
Example:
GR = Gray
G = Green
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the
second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Example:
,,,,
,,,,
3C indicates
,,,,
that it is inside
,,,,
Junction Block
,,,,
,,,,No.3
,,,,
L–Y
[G] : Indicates related system.
L
(Blue)
[H] : Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness
connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows ( ).
Outside numerals are pin numbers.
Y
(Yellow)
[C] : The position of the parts is the same as shown in
the wiring diagram and wire routing.
[D] : Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female
and male connectors.
Example : Numbered in order
from upper left to
lower right
Numbered in order
from upper right to
lower left
Female
[I]
Male (
)
: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and
connector, etc. when the vehicle model, engine
type, or specification is different.
[J] : Indicates a shielded cable.
Female
Male
The numbering system for the overall wiring
diagram is the same as above
[E] : Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and
only the Relay Block No. is shown to distinguish
it from the J/B.
Example :
[K] : Indicates and located on ground point.
[L] : The same code occuring on the next page
indicates that the wire harness is continuous.
Indicates Relay Block No.1
J
SYSTEMS
LOCATION
SYSTEMS
LOCATION
ABS
TMC Made . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19–2
TMMK Made . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20–2
Light Auto Turn Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9–1
ABS and Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18–2
Power Outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16–3
Air Conditioning
Automatic A/C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29–2
Manual A/C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27–2
Power Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22–2
Auto Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24–2
Back–Up Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8–4
Moon Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21–2
Power Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1~29–1
Power Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13–2
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26–3
Cigarette Lighter and Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16–4
Radio and Player
Built–In Type Amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24–3
Separate Type Amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23–2
Combination Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25–2
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26–2
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17–2
Remote Control Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12–4
Door Lock Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14–2
Shift Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16–2
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator
1MZ–FE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2
5S–FE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–2
SRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–2
Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–4
Engine Control and Engine Immobiliser System
1MZ–FE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2
5S–FE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2
Starting and Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2
Stop Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11–4
Taillight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11–2
Theft Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15–2
Headlight
w/ Daytime Running Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7–2
w/o Daytime Running Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–2
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21–4
Illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–2
Interior Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9–3
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21–3
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8–2
Wiper and Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12–2
Wireless Door Lock Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14–5
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
SYSTEM INDEX
1 CAMRY ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
P o w er S o u rc e
S ta rting a n d Ig n ition
1
C ha rg in g
3
2
4
B–G
W
*
*
*
*
*
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
W–R 7 AM2
IG2 6
B–R
ST2 8
R
W
B–Y
1 : 1MZ–FE
2 : 5S–FE
3 : w/ Daytime Running Light
4 : TMC Made
5 : TMMK Made
B–R(*2)
J25
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B
1
Y
(*3)
4 IK2
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
Y
(*3)
6 EB1
R–L
IGT1
GND
6
7
3
BR–Y
(*1)
GR
(*1)
Y
IGT2
5
BR
(*1)
To Engine Control
Module<2–8>
ED : *1
EC : *2
BR
(*2)
Rear side of the surge
tank(*1)
Intake manifold(*2)
G1 B , G2 A
GENERATOR
IGT3
BR
(*1)
IGF
W
Y
(* 3)
C
+B
4
To Engine
Control Module<3–11>
R–L
To Daytime Running
Light Relay
(Main)<7–2>
Y
N1
NOISE FILTER
(Ignition)
IGC1
Y
(w/o Daytime Running Light)
IGC2 I 2
IGNITER
J19
A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
BR
(*2)
IGC3
A
9
B
GR(*2 *4)
B–O(*2 *5)
BR(*2)
10
A
N1
NOISE FILTER
(Ignition)
1
1
2
G
2
To Engine Control
Module<3–11>
B–R
2
B–R
2
Y
B A
1
4 IG2
BR
LG–B
(*1)
To Bulb
Check Relay
[Comb. Meter]
<25–6>
A
1
A
W–R
(*1)
B A
2
L
IG
C B
GR(*1 *4)
B–O(*1 *5)
GR(*4)
B–O(*5)
C B
To Engine
Control
Module<2–10>
Left kick panel
II2
GR(*4)
B–O(*5)
BATTERY
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
J7 A , J8 B
W–B
10
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
FL MAIN
3. 0W
6
GR(*4)
B–O(*5)
(A/T)
B–G
S1 B , S2 A
STARTER
11 A
B
N
GR
B–R
GR(*4)
B–O(*5)
(M/T)
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
W–B
1 A
B–R
100A
ALT
GR(*4)
B–O(*5)
F6 C , F9 F
1
I5
IGNITION COIL NO. 1
P
1
A
B–R
F4 A , F5 B ,
I6
IGNITION COIL NO. 2
1 C
A
B–R
2 F
I7
IGNITION COIL NO. 3
1 F
P1
PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW
5
1 B
A
B–R
B
B–R
B–R
A
4
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
A
2
B
2
Y–R(*2)
11 II2
C7
CLUTCH
START
SW
11 2J
W–R
9 2K
3
W–R
(*2)
5 2D
3
2
B(*2)
3 2B
1
4
B–R
(*1)
2
IGF IGT GND
B–W
(A/T)
3
12 II3
B–W
(M/T)
1
GND IGT IGF
W–R
B–W
(A/T)
B
1
ST RELAY
40A MAIN
30A AM2
5A ALT–S
B–R
B–G
1 2A
5
4 B
2 1J
B–R
(*2)
BR(*2)
2
1 1B
+B
B–G
4 2L
1
+B
B–R
3 2C
1
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
13 II3
8 1C
B–R
(*1)
B
3 1J
B–W
40A AM1
W–R
B–W
2
1 1K
10A GAUGE
5A
IGN
13 A
I4
IGNITION
COIL AND
IGNITER
NO. 2
C8 A , C9 B
B–R
(*2)
5A
STARTER
W
2 1K
I3
IGNITION
COIL AND
IGNITER
NO. 1
B
CHARGE WARNING
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
W
To Engine Control
Module<2–9><3–10>
5 1B
B
B–Y
B
B–R
8 1T
B–R
3 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
B–R
B–R
4 1K
B–R
5 1K
1 A
L
B B
IG A
S A
1
B–G
2
3
W
J
1
W
B
25A A/F HTR
W
(*1)
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
B
100A ALT
40A AM1
B–G
7. 5A OBD
W
FL
1. 25B
C10
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
[COMB. METER]
G–R
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
IG
A
W–B
W–B
B–Y
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
Under the left
center pillar
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J7 A , J8 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
BL
A
R–L
5
7 1J
BR
Left radiator
side support
B
(*1)
L–B
M
4
SIL
7
C
C
C
(Shielded)
W
EB
EFI RELAY
W–B
(* 1)
B
(*1)
F14
FUEL
PUMP
7 ID1
8 1J
SG
5
BR
C
A
B
B
BR
J7 A , J8 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
C
B
BR
BR
A
B
4
E1
3
+B
12
TE1
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
8
* 1 : California
BR
BR
B–Y
BR
L–W
W
B–W
B–R
B–Y
B–R
B–Y
G–R
G–R
B(*1)
B–Y
BATTERY
30A AM2
L–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
15A EFI
2
A A
A B
W–B
1 ES1
B–R
7
D
D
4
CG
BAT
D5
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
16
W
1 A
2
W–B
(*1)
2
4 EB1
CIR OPN RELAY
1 C
2
L–B
3
1
1
G–R
1
2
1
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 F
10 2C
3
1
2 1D
R–L
5 2C 2 2J
A B
C A
5
7 IK1
1 1K
W–B
4 2F
1
2
C A
B–R
B–R
B–R
3
From Airbag
Sensor Assembly<28–4>
1 F
1 2A
3
5
2
L
(*1)
2
5
B–W
B–R
W–R
B–W
(* 1)
B–W
B–R
B–R
1
7 2K
7 1W
5A
IGN
3 1K 8 1C
12
II3
B–R
1 1B
B–Y
8 2J
B–Y
B–R
B–R
B–Y
10A GAUGE
4 2L
ST2
IG2 6
IG1 4
I16
IGNITION SW
7 AM2
2 AM1
2
E ng in e C o n trol an d E n gine Im m ob ilis e r S y s tem (1 M Z – F E )
N
M
L
K
J
I
H
G
F
E
D
C
B
A
(Cont. next page)
L–W
4 1B
1
5 1B
5 1K
W–R
2
2 1K
W
ACC
B–Y
1
2
L
(*1)
1
1
P o w e r S o ur ce
B
10 1J
2 CAMRY
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
BR
(Shielded)
J3
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
W
W
G–R
J35 A , J36 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A/F HTR RELAY(*1)
2 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
(Cont. next page)
* 1 : California
* 2 : Except California
* 3 : w/ Engine Immobiliser System
E n g in e C o n trol an d E n gine Im m ob ilis er S y s te m (1 M Z – F E )
5
A
B
B–R
A
A
B–R
B–W
A
A
To A/C Control
Assembly<29–8>
From Igniter
<1–2><1–3>
From ABS and Traction
ECU<18–2>
2
To A/C Amplifier
<27–4>
To A/C Control Assembly
<29–8>
From A/C Amplifier<27–4>
From A/C Control Assembly
<29–8>
1
2
To Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]<25–8>
2
1
V
1
B–R
1
2
I13
INJECTOR NO. 6
2
A
B–R
1
A
I12
INJECTOR NO. 5
2
I11
INJECTOR NO. 4
1
I10
INJECTOR NO. 3
I9
INJECTOR NO. 2
I8
INJECTOR NO. 1
B–Y
1 ID1
1
V
(*6)
GR
BR–Y
LG–B
W–R
L
(*9)
LG
(*9)
B
(*9)
W
(*9)
BR–W
(*9)
LG–B
B–Y
V–W
V
G
R–L
W
Y
R
L
B–R
B–Y
B–W
W
L–W
B–Y
10 ID1
2
A
B–R
L–W
A
B–R
W
B–R
F
B–Y(*3)
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B–R
E
8
B–R
B–Y
V7
VSV(Vapor Pressure Sensor)
D
7
6
B–Y
C
* 4 : TMC Made
* 5 : TMMK Made
* 6 : Automatic A/C
B–Y
16 A
6 E
+B
W
1 A
2 A
FC
HTS
3 A
9 B
6 D
# 10
1 E
#20
OXS
8 B
EOM
HAFR AFR+
13 C
AFR–
13 B
A/C
EGR
16 B
ACT
14 A
NEO
EVP1
18 E
21 A
EFI+
RSO
7 D
16 E
13 A
EFI–
20 A
25 E
TRC+ TRC–
RSC
13 E
IGF
12 E
IGT3
HTR OXR1
3 D 11 D
15 E
14 B
11 E
IGT2
TW
IGT1
HTL OXL1
4 D 12 D
A
A
B–Y
4
+B
2
B
BR
BR
BR
J20
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
OX
E1
B–Y
B–Y
B–Y
4
3
HT
BR
BR
2
II1
(Shielded)
A
2
B
A
E1
1
BR
B–Y
B–Y
+B
Y–R
A
OX
H4
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)(*2)
B–Y
A
3
HT
BR
A
B–Y
1
(Shielded)
A
W
2
L–B
3
H3
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)(*2)
A
1
Y–B
R–W
1
B–Y
G–R
1
I1
IDLE AIR
CONTROL VALVE
G–R
B
1
LG
B
(*1)
2
B–Y
B
B(*1)
2
V5
VSV(EVAP)
BR
4
Y–G
BR
2
BR
B–Y
3
2
V4
VSV(EGR)
4
1
B
N
25 B
SPD
ACIS
17 E
(Shielded)
2
BR
M
AFL–
21 D
B–W(*4)
L (*5)
BR
B
L
22 B
TPC
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
L (*4)
B–W(*5)
4
BR
K
# 60
AFL+
12 D
B–W
2
(Shielded)
E1
3
A29
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)(*1)
+B
1
R (*4)
B–R(*5)
OX
G(*4)
BR(*5)
HT
B–R
3
A28
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)(*1)
G–R
J
4 D
9 A
4 E
#50
HAFL
3 D 11 D 20 D
BR
5 EB1
B
10 IG3
1
(Shielded)
E A
P–B
E A
B–Y
G–R
B A
G–R
I
3 E
# 40
R–Y
E B
G–R
H
2 E
#30
V6
VSV(Intake Air Control)
E B
H8
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
B B
B–Y
B–Y
G
5 D
MREL BATT IGSW
B–Y
B–Y
J27 A , J28 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B A
8 A
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D , E11 E
6 A
B B
SIL
B–Y
B–Y
(*3)
9 II3
11 A
TC
BR
BR
BR
BR
BR
B–Y
BR
BR
6
II3
BR
BR
D
E
F
G
BR
BR
(*1)
C
Rear side of
surge tank
ED
J
* 4 : TMC Made
* 5 : TMMK Made
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
Cowl side
panel LH
J26
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
B
BR
(*1)
BR
(*1)
P2
POWER STEERING
OIL PRESSURE SW
1
B–L
To Tachometer
[Comb. Meter]
<25–5>
B–O
CF
29 E
D B
1 II2
B–W
1
2
L
BR
NE+
16 D
BR
C2
CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
2
1
B–R
(Shielded)
3 EC1
(Shielded)
W
1 EC1
From Park/Neutral
Start SW(A/T) or
Clutch Start SW(M/T)
<1–2>
W
W
2 EC1
STA
7 A
GR(*4)
B–O(*5)
1
K1
KNOCK SENSOR 1
(Shielded)
K2
KNOCK SENSOR 2
W
1
BR
4 EC1
(Shielded)
KNKR
27 E
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
NE–
24 D
G22+
10 E
(Shielded)
RXCK
CODE
BR
(* 1)
10 C
5 C
4 C
BR
BR
(*5 M/T)
Surge
tank RH
EC
BR
A
A
BR A
BR A
BR
(*2)
A
BR A
G
F
E
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BR A
D
C
B
B–Y
A
A
BR
BR
BR
BR
(*1)
BR
BR A
IMLD
16 C
L
KSW
11 C
B–W
NSW
L–B
20 B
4 IG3
G–W
(*3)
8 IG3
3
R–L
(*3)
R–Y
C1
CAMSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
E1
E03
E02
E01
17 D 30 E 31 E 21 E
2
1
4
L–Y
(*3)
2
T7
TRANSPONDER
KEY AMPLIFIER
5
1
A
B–Y
(*3)
9
THW
14 D
13 D
W–B
(*3)
E1
EGR GAS TEMP.
SENSOR
THG
G–Y
E5
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMP. SENSOR
From ” STARTER” Fuse
<1–2>
From FAN NO. 1 Relay
<26–3>
TXCT
G–B
2
1
BR
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D , E11 E
2 D
VC
VTA1
23 D
15 A
STP
ELS2
18 A
10
BR
ELS
G–O
19 A
From ” TAIL” Fuse
<11–2>
B–Y
18 D
From ” MIRROR–HEATER”
Fuse<26–2>
E2
1
VTA VC
E2
2
BR
3
G–W
From Stop Light SW
<11–4>
L–B
G–W
B–W
KNKL
28 E
Y
BR
Y
L
To Unlock
Warning SW
<21–3>
G–W
(Shielded)
T2
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
R–Y
F A
TACH
J27 A , J28 B
Y
Y
To Theft
Deterrent ECU
<15–3>
To A/C Amplifier
<27–3>
To A/C Control
Assembly<29–8>
B–O
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
BR
BR
27 B
PTNK
17 A
Y
6 ID1
Y
P
B–O
ADJ2
24 E
V1
VAPOR PRESSURE
SENSOR
3 II1
2
Y
3
PTNK
P
VCC
1
E2
BR
5 ID1
4
II1
BR
2 ID1
BR
11
F A
1
Y
E2
EGR VALVE POSITION
SENSOR
BR
E n gine C o ntro l a n d E ng in e Im mo b ilise r S y s te m(1 M Z – F E )
B
E05
8 D
BR
(*1)
PS
9 D
E04
1 D
E2G
THA
19 D
3
22 E
W–G
BR
2
VG
10 D
5
2
BR
M2
MASS AIR FLOW
METER
BR
(*1)
EGLS
* 1 : California
* 2 : Except California
* 3 : w/ Engine Immobiliser System
1
3
4
L–Y
22 D
B–Y
12
R–B
P
BR
2 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
IE
W–B
(*3)
MEMO
3 CAMRY
B
7. 5A OBD
40A AM1
B–R
B–R
Left radiator
side support
30A AM2
B
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–G
W–B
BL
A
5
M
4
L–B
W–B
EB
L–B
BATTERY
L–B
F14
FUEL
PUMP
CIR OPN RELAY
B–Y
Under the left
center pillar
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
FL MAIN
3. 0W
5 ID1
6 ID1
P
7 ID1
C10
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
[COMB. METER]
Y
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
G–R
1 II2
1
3
VCC
8
II4
7
II4
V1
VAPOR PRESSURE
SENSOR
1 A
E A
L–W
100A
ALT
G–R
5 EB1
R–L
4 EB1
B–Y
E A
B A
2
PTNK
P
10 IG3
B–R
(*1)
1
2
B A
BR
1
3
2
2
Y
1 C
4 2F 5 2C
E B
E2
1
2 ID1
PIM
2
Y
3
VC
E2
1
3 II2
BR
Y
M1
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE SENSOR
BR
2 F
10 2C
E B
B–Y
B B
BR
BR
4
3
1
2
B
B–Y
B–Y(*1)
G–R
G–R
L–R
P
B–Y
LG
Y
BR
B–Y
B–W(* 1)
B–R(*1)
B–R
B–Y
B–Y
B–Y
T2
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
BR
1 F
15A EFI
2 2J
7
II3
B–Y
B–R
1 2A
EFI RELAY
1 1B
1
9
B–Y
(*1)
4 1B
5
B–R
1
D
R–L
2
1
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
2 1D
1 1K
BR
3
1
5
7 IK1
10A
GAUGE
B–R
(*1)
5A
IGN
8 1C
3
* 1 : w/ Engine Immobiliser System
* 2 : w/o Engine Immobiliser System
BR
1
7 2K
B–W(*1)
B–R(*2)
7 1W
3 1K
B–R
(*2) (*2)
2
W–R
8 2J
B–R
B–Y
B–R
B–R
(*1)
4 2L
ST2
IG2 6
IG1 4
2
B–Y
2 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
7 AM2
2 AM1
ACC
B
B–Y
E ng ine C on tro l a nd E n g in e Imm o bilis e r S y s tem (5 S – F E )
BR
10 1J
W
5 1B
5 1K
W–R
1
P ow e r S ou rc e
R
Q
P
O
N
M
L
K
J
I
H
G
F
E
D
C
B
A
(Cont. next page)
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
Y
LG
Y
B–Y
A13
A/C EVAPORATOR
TEMP. SENSOR
L–R
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J27 A , J28 B
B–Y
B–Y
B–Y
B
G–R
W–B
(Cont. next page)
3 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
E ng in e C o n trol an d E ng in e Im m ob ilis e r S y stem (5 S – F E )
A
B
C
B–Y
B–R(*1)
B–W(*1)
10
ID1
B–Y
1
B–Y
2
V
2 A
7 C
6 C
15 B
3 C (*1)
1 A
10 C
9 C
23 C
22 C (*2)
#20
#30
# 40
+B
ISCO
ISCC
B
(*3)
C
EGR
EVP
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
TXCT
9 D (*1)
SIL
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
2
D5
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 3
II4
7
2 II3
A B
B B
H8
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
P–B
BR
7 1J
C A
3
1
OX
HT
+B
2
E1
4
W–B
(*1)
B
B–Y
(*1)
B–Y
W–B
From Airbag Sensor
Assembly<28–4>
C A
J7 A , J8 B
A A
W–B
5
1 II3
SG
5
W–B
8 1J
1
5 B
W
B
CG
4
16 A
HT2
14 C (*1)
21 C (*2)
(Shielded)
BAT
16
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
BR
L–Y
(* 1)
4
BR
G–W
(* 1)
2
B
R–L
(* 1)
3
C
W
SIL
13 B
(Shielded)
II4
(Shielded)
1
W
OX2
6 A
P–B
CODE
8 D
B
RXCK
3 D
G–R
G–R
BATT
B
V–W
12 A
12 A
4 II4
T7
TRANSPONDER KEY AMPLIFIER
L–R
1
From Diode(Idle–Up)
<26–1>
P
P2
POWER STEERING
OIL PRESSURE SW
B–Y
9 C
24 C
2 A (*2)
B–R
B–L
G–R
G–R
L–R
P
Y
LG
10 C
25 C
#10
A
B–Y
(*4)
2
P–B
12 B
B–O
5 A 14 A
W
10 B
B–Y
7 B
B–Y
2 B
W
11 B
I11
INJECTOR NO. 4
1 B
B–R
3 B
ELS
Y
4 B
PSSW
4 C 13 A
I10
INJECTOR NO. 3
FC
B–R
W
4 A 14 A
B–Y
12 II2
B–Y(*1)
BR
A
B–Y
B
Cowl side
panel LH
IE
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument
panel
brace LH
BR
R
THR
11 B
LG
P
Q
PTNK
8 B
Y
O
PIM
2 B
Y–B
N
VTA
10 B
G–B
M
VC
1 B
1
11 C
IGSW
G–B
Y–B
L
THA
3 B
1
3
11 C
L–Y
(*1)
THW
1
1
12 C
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D
4 B
2
2
12 C
G–W
(*1)
2
MREL
1
R
TPC
1 A
1
B
2
R–L
(*1)
E5
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMP. SENSOR
I14
INTAKE AIR TEMP.
SENSOR
2
1
7 D
2
L
8 B
B–R
(* 1)
16 B
B–W
(* 1)
BR
BR
9 B
9 B
I9
INJECTOR NO. 2
I8
INJECTOR NO. 1
6 II4
2
B
B–R
B–R
B–W
(*1)
5 II4
V
BR
E2
1
K
B
V5
VSV(EVAP)
B
V4
VSV(EGR)
B
V
BR
I1
IDLE AIR CONTROL VALVE
2
V
BR
J21
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B
1
I
B
12 II3
1 ID1
J
B
B–Y
B–R
B–R
V7
VSV(Vapor Pressure Sensor)
H
B
B
B–R
G
8
J19
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B
B–Y
F
* 3 : California
* 4 : Except California
B–Y
E
7
6
B–Y
B–Y
D
5
B–Y
* 1 : w/ Engine Immobiliser System
* 2 : w/o Engine Immobiliser System
BR
BR
D
E
J
B
(*3)
C
A11
AIR FUEL
RATIO SENSOR
G
(*3)
L–B
R–Y
R–Y
W
B–O
J27 A
BR
A
A
A
A
Intake
manifold
14 C (*2)
15 C
EOM
2 D
BR
R–Y
EC
Intake
manifold
BR
BR
BR
EC
A
BR
A
A
TE1
E01
E02
E03
13 C 26 C 25 C (*1)
13 C 26 C 16 B (*2)
A
J23
JUNCTION
A CONNECTOR
IGT2
BR
BR
6 II3
E1
24 C
IGF
BR
BR
L
BR
1
13 B
E04
15 C
BR
To Tachometer
[Comb. Meter]
<25–5>
1
5 C
KNK
IGT1
15 B (*2)
BR
(*4)
3
E1
1 : w/ Engine Immobiliser System
2 : w/o Engine Immobiliser System
3 : California
4 : Except California
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
7 B (*1)
8
TE1
+B
12
*
*
*
*
BR
BR
L–B
To Unlock
Warning SW
<21–3>
L–B
To Theft
Deterrent
System<15–3>
(Shielded)
1
2
17 C
L
8 IG3
2
G+
(Shielded)
F A
NE–
6 D 11 D
STA
12 B
NSW
BR
4 IG3
B–O
F A
4 C
12 D
NE+
MGC A/C SW LOCK
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
PRS
BR
(*3)
9 II4
LOCK IN
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D
STP
3 C 19 C
23 C 17 C 22 C
20 C
BR
3 II4
9 A
8 A
V–W
8 A
7 A
SPD
HT1
H3
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
4 D
(Shielded)
TACH
OX1
11 A
11 A
22 A
22 A
20 A
10 A
10 A
15 A
21 A
L–Y
21 A
From MG CLT
Relay<27–3>
18 C 13 A
R–B
19 C 19 A
From A/C SW
<27–4>
1 D
L(*5)
W(*6)
(*3)
4 A
R–W
KSW
W
(*4)
9 A
From A/C SW
<27–4>
AF+
L–Y
(*4)
1 C
G–W
8 C
From Stop Light
SW<11–4>
W–L
6 B
G
5 B
From A/C Dual
Pressure SW<27–4>
6 B
From ” STARTER”
Fuse<1–2>
B–W
(A/T)
GR(*5)
B–O(*6)
6 B
W–L
10 II3
11
From Ignition Coil
and Igniter
No. 1, No. 2<1–3><1–4>
B
AF–
14 B
HT
1
W–R
HTAF
(*3)
14 B
B–W(*5)
O (*6)
2 C
BR
2 C
OX
3
E1
4
To A/C Magnetic
Clutch and Lock
Sensor<27–4>
Y–R
BR
E
AF–
4
+B
2
BR
BR
(*4)
10
From Park/Neutral Position
SW(A/T) or Clutch Start
SW(M/T)<1–2>
L–W
IMLD
HT
1
AF+
3
B–Y
(* 4)
+B
2
9
E n gine C o ntro l a n d E ng in e Im mo bilis er S y s te m (5 S – F E )
B–Y
BR
D
B–Y
(*4)
B
A
B–Y
3 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
12
* 5 : TMC Made
* 6 : TMMK Made
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
BR(*4)
BR
BR
BR
BR
(*3)
K1
KNOCK SENSOR 1
(Shielded)
B–W
C1
CAMSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
C2
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
BR
B–R
(Shielded)
To Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]
<25–8>
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4 CAMRY
1
2
2 AM1
IG1 4
3 1K
B–Y
1 1K
1 1J
A
7
5 II2
6 II2
1 IJ1
3
II3
4 II2
A
G–W
D
R–B
A
D
R–B
7 2K 8 2J
D
R
W–R
B–Y
E
L–W(*3)
0 (*4)
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–W
J35
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
C
L–W(* 3)
0 (*4)
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
B–W
5 1B
4 2L
II2
Y
B–R
W
E
Y E
Y
2 1K
9
G–W
PL
8
R–B
RL
9
R–L
I16
IGNITION SW
5 1K
2 1D
NL
10
R
7 1W
DL
3
B–R
ST2
2L
4
L–W
2
II2
LL
Y
B–R
P1
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
IG2 6
2
C
A
R–L
10A
GAUGE
5A
IGN
W–R 7 AM2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
B
1 : California
2 : Except California
3 : TMC Made
4 : TMMK Made
4
R–L
J28 B
R–L
ACC
3
F
B
R–L
B–Y
B–R
W
*
*
*
*
E le ctro n ic a lly C on tro lled T ra ns m is s io n a nd A /T Ind ic a tor (1 M Z – F E )
P o w er S ou rc e
R–B
1
C A
A B
3
16 IG3
8 A
2 A
MREL IGSW
12 B
3 B
2 B
L
2
R
7 E
8 E
8 A
9 A
16 B
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
COMBINATION METER
G–O
A
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
C
O2
A
O/D MAIN SW
2
4 W–B A
A
B
ED
BR
(*1)
B
Rear side of
surge tank
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J26
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
EC
W–B
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
BR
(*1)
A
Surge tank RH
C
G–O C
G–O
E3
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
12 A
G–O
1
BR
Left radiator
side support
10 A
OD2
11 IG3
BR
(*2)
From
Cruise Control
ECU<17–3>
W–B
EB
7 A
10 B
BR
B
W
Y
R
L
W–B
BATTERY
S2
E1
17 D
BR
S1
E02
31 E
BR
SL
6
E01
21 E
2
BR
SLN+
3
E03
30 E
R
SLN–
2
V3
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(Electronically Controlled
Transmission)
1
7 II2
L–B
4
L–B
A
J26
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A L–B
NC2+
14 E
G
L–B
V
P–L
W–L
B A
26 E
A
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
NC2–
11 A
P
9 E
IDLO
R
S2
6 A
4 B
OD1
N
S1
24 B
D
20 E
B–Y
B B
B–Y
FL MAIN
3. 0W
19 E
SL
B–Y
B–G
J27 A , J28 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
1 A
16 A
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
100A
ALT
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
1 C
SLN+
SPD
2
E 7 A , E 8 B , E 9 C , E10 D , E11 E
SLN–
22 B
G–W
E2
L
B–R
B–R
2 F
THW
15 IG3
R–B
VTA1
R
VC
10 1H
B–R
NSW
O/D OFF
B–Y
W–B
W–B
B
2 D 23 D 14 D 18 D
20 B
14 IG3
O
B–R
BATT
13 IG3
Y
D
7 C
1 A
5 1V
D
R–L
L–R
Y–B
V–W
R–B
5 2C 4 2F 2 2J
+B
1 F
Y
1 2A
B–R
B–W
B–Y
1 1B
B–R
2
Y
1
See Engine Control
and Engine Immobiliser
System<2–9><2–10><2–11>
To Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]
<25–8>
From Cruise
Control ECU
<17–3>
L–W(*3)
0 (*4)
15A
EFI
C A
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
EFI RELAY
40A AM1
30A
AM2
5
J27 A , J28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
IF
Left kick panel
J
W
B–R
40A AM1
B–R
B–R
L–B
L–B
L–B
B–G
J23
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Intake
manifold
BR
EC
9 A
Intake manifold
13 C 26 C
16 B
SPD
8 A
To Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]
<25–8>
BR
LOCK–UP
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
J27 A , J28 B
W–B
W–B
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
EC
A
A
E02
BR
OD2
5 A (*3)
7 A (*4)
IDLO
11 IG3
C
4
2
C
C
12 A
7 C
O2
O/D MAIN
SW
W–B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
6 A
11 A
A
IF
A
A
16 B
7 A
W–B
B
NO. 2
W
NO. 1
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
BR
(California)
A
14 C
BR
15 C
E01
25 C 13 C 26 C
BR
S2
E1
24 C
OD1
G–O
E3 A , E4 B
S1
7 II2
J25
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
L–B
E04
15 C
E03
R
2
L
V–W
1 B
A
A
6 C
21 C
S2
IGSW
W–B
EB
SL
3 B
P
1 A
7 C
1 C
8 C
V
B A
B B
B–Y
G–O
Left radiator
side support
12 A
20 C
S1
STP
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
TE1
20 A
8 A
9 A
15 IG3
10 1H
5 1V
4 II2
II3
Left kick panel
7
PL
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
COMBINATION METER
10 A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
BATTERY
EFI RELAY
12 A
E2
E7 A , E8 B , E9 C
THW
3 A (* 3)
3 A (* 4)
18 A
O/D OFF
FL MAIN
3. 0W
W–B
SL
VTA
J27 A , J28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 A
B–Y
+B
VC
17 A
17 A
16 A
18 A
15 A
19 A
N
100A
ALT
B
1 C
B–Y
NSW
1 A
J4
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–L
BATT MREL
9 A
4 A
7 B
15 B
B–R
(*3)
9 B
Y
9 B
R–B
4 B
Y–B
4 B
L–R
10 B
14 IG3
13 IG3
16 IG3
Y
11 B
D
D
L
O
1 B
From Cruise
Control ECU
<17–3>
2
B–R
1 B
B–R
(*3)
22 A
R–B
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
22 A
C A
R
2 F
B–W
(*3)
7 D
A B
C A
A
3
8
RL
R–B
1 A
See Engine Control and
Engine Immobiliser System
<3–5><3–10><3–11>
L–W(*1)
O (*2)
2 A
II4
Y
2 2J
6
Y
5 2C 4 2F
3
5
L–W(*1)
O (*2)
G–W
1 F
1 2A
2
1
D
A
B–R
1 1B
15A
EFI
R–B
D
L–W(* 1)
O (*2)
1
30A
AM2
7 2K 8 2J
R–L
2
W–R
4 2L
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
1 IJ1
9 II2
9
NL
B–R
2 1K
E
E
II2
10
DL
R
L–W(* 1)
O (*2)
E
6
3
2L
P1
A/T INDICATOR LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW]
R–B
B–Y
Y
5 II2
Y
R–L
2
II2
4
LL
L–W
5 1B
J28 B
R–L
A
A
B–R
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F
B
F
B
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
C
4
R
G–W
B–W
(* 3)
B–R
(* 4)
2 1D
10A
GAUGE
1 1J
R–L
R
I16
IGNITION SW
7 1W
5A
IGN
1 1K
3
1 : TMC Made
2 : TMMK Made
3 : w/ Engine Immobiliser System
4 : w/o Engine Immobiliser System
R–B
5 1K
B–R
IG2 6
3 1K
R–L
*
*
*
*
G–W
ST2
B–Y
IG1 4
ACC
2
R–L
W–R 7 AM2
2 AM1
B–R
E le ctron ic a lly C on tro lle d T ra ns m is s io n a nd A /T Ind ica to r (5 S – F E )
B–Y
W
1
P o w er S ou rc e
5 CAMRY
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
P
G–O
G–O
BR
From
Cruise Control
ECU<17–3>
B–Y
6 CAMRY
H ea d lig ht (w /o D ay time R u nn in g L ig h t)
P ow er S ou rc e
1
3
2
2
4
1
HEAD
RELAY
40A
MAIN
4
15A
HEAD
(LH)
3
15A
HEAD
(RH)
2
1
3 2B
8 2K 3 2G
3
B
2
1
1
2
D B
D B
J35 A , J36 B
8
13
EL
F B
R–L
F B
R–Y
C13
COMBINATION SW
R–L
4
F4 A , F6 C
R–B
R–B
1 C
H
T
HF
HL
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
HI
D A
OFF
F A
F A
TAIL
R–L
HEAD
R–L
R–B
LIGHT
DIMMER SW
CONTROL SW
B–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
H2
HEADLIGHT
RH
R–B
I17
INTEGRATION
RELAY
1 A
3
H1
HEADLIGHT
LH
3
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
R–W
R–B
B
R–B
B
8 2C
R
To Theft Deterrent
ECU<15–3>
6 2G
R–B
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
R–B B
4 2G
LOW
HIGH
3 IG1
FLASH
17
R–L
16
7
W–B
8
R–B
C9
HIGH BEAM
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
A
A
BATTERY
R–L
9
W–B
W–B
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8 1J
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
7 1J
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
A
W–B
W–B
A
Instrument panel
brace LH
IF
Left kick panel
J
B–R
B
B
B–R
B–R
W–B
IG
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
R–B
B–G
7
1J
8
1J
B
I17
INTEGRATION RELAY
A
A
A
16
W–B
W–B
To Theft Deterrent ECU
<15–3>
IF
A
A
9
Left kick panel
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
LIGHT
DIMMER SW
CONTROL SW
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
FLASH
HIGH
LOW
8
18
8 EB1
20
DIM
2
4
R
2
2
2
7 EB1
4
3
2
2
5 2G
2
2
EB
2
1
3
1
W–B
Instrument panel
brace LH
W–B
J1
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B
HI
R–L
A
B
HF
C9
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
T
7
3 IG1
21
H–ON
H–LP
2
2
R
BATTERY
R–B
J27 A , J28 B
HEAD
H
8
R–Y
TAIL
OFF
EL
13
3
R–W
3
4
R–Y
R–B
D6
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY(Main)
IND
HEAD RELAY
FL MAIN
3. 0W
2
10A GAUGE
R–Y
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
12
HI
T
W–R
3
1
W–R
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
V–Y
TAIL
2
2
R
15A
HEAD LH(UPR)
1 A
V–Y
+B
19
2
1
R
4 2G
R–B
100A
ALT
P–L
2 F
P–L
H
R–L
E
R–W
CHG–
To Brake Fluid
Level Warning
SW<25–5>
PKB
Y
BRK
R
IG
R–W
CSE
G–R
CSO
From
TAILLIGHT Relay
<10–1><11–2>
17
G–Y
16
R
CSB
22
To Integration
Relay
<10–1><11–1>
13
3 2G
2
5A DRL NO. 2
14
To Parking
Brake SW
<25–5>
4
From Generator
<1–4>
23
8 2K
3
1
DIM RELAY
5
7 1V
40A
MAIN
4
R–L
R
15
D A
1 1W
2
1
3 2B
4
2 2G
R–B
Left radiator
side support
W–B
DRL NO. 4
RELAY
R–B
H1
HEADLIGHT
LH
15A
HEAD RH(UPR)
6
8 IG1
GR–R
9 IG1
GR–R
4 IG1
F B
R–L
3
CLTE
SHORT PIN
4
12 2J
7. 5A
DOME
R
CLTS
2
1
1 2A
3
R–B
1
CLTB
1 1J
1 1K
2
2
1
R–W
R
10A
H–LP LH(LWR)
1 1B
1
A40
AUTOMATIC LIGHT
CONTROL SENSOR
IG1 4
ACC
I16
IGNITION SW
2 AM1
B–Y
B
B
H ea dlig ht (w / D a y tim e R u n ning L igh t)
R–L
2
2
3
1
2
1
2
D2
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHT RESISTOR
R–B
H2
HEADLIGHT
RH
3
1
2
R–G
1 C
40A
AM1
2
2 1K
W
1
P o w e r S o ur ce
10A
H–LP RH(LWR)
1 F
7 CAMRY
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
R–Y
R–Y
C13
COMBINATION SW
W–B
R–B
8 CAMRY
P o w er S ou rc e
T urn S ign al a nd H a za rd W ar ning L igh t
1
B ac k – U p L igh t
3
2
4
B
ACC
2 AM1
IG1 4
B–Y
1 1K
R–L
R–L
10A GAUGE
W
7. 5A TURN
I16
IGNITION SW
1 2A
10A
HAZARD
2 II2
F
2 1L
1 1J
H7
HAZARD SW
2
F
40A
AM1
W
10
TB
R–L
TL
2
B2
TR
TL
OFF
LH
ON
OFF
TB
A
TR
5
6
G–W
G–R
1
3
G–Y
B–R
G–B
8 1V
6 1H
5 1A
3
8 A (A/T)
1 B (M/T)
1
3
R10
BACK–UP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
W–B
W–B
5 1V
R–B
C
W–B
Back panel center
3
13 1S
R–B
1
3 II3
R8
BACK–UP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
BP
2 B (M/T)
R–B
2
W–B
W–B
IF
2 A (A/T)
R–B
3
W–B
Left kick panel
R–L
(5S–FE)
R–B
W–B
A
A
B B
A
W–B
Left radiator
side support
B A
W–B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F2
FRONT TURN SIGNAL
J35 A , J36 B
LIGHT RH
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
G–Y
G–Y
5
2 1A
R11
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
G–Y
6
W–B
EB
C 9 B , C10 C
TURN SIGNAL INDICATOR
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
IG
G–Y
Instrument panel
brace LH
16 B
W–B
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 C
LH
A
W–B
BATTERY
W–B
2
F1
FRONT TURN
SIGNAL LIGHT LH
G–B
3
1 B
RH
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
5
1 EB1
G–B
B–G
B
C
6
G–B
G–B
1 C
C
R9
REAR TURN SIGNAL LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
C
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
R–B
6 1S
G–B
F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
10 1C
8 1H
11 1S
G–B
F4 A , F6 C ,
G–Y
2 F
100A
ALT
D
G–Y
T6
TURN SIGNAL
FLASHER
B–R
B–R
1 F
1
G–B
2
P1 A
BACK–UP LIGHT SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW](A/T)
D
G–Y
B1 B
BACK–UP LIGHT SW
(M/T)
G–Y
1 A
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
RH
A
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
(1MZ–FE)
9
G–B
7
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C13
TURN SIGNAL SW
[COMB. SW]
1
1 1B
R–L
(5S–FE)
G–B
8
B1
F
R–L
(1MZ–FE)
G–R
2 1K
J28
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3 2K
R–L
C
J27
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Under the left
center pillar
A
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BL
J
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
L6
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SW
R–Y
L5
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT
1
2
R–Y
1
R
From Theft
Deterrent
ECU<15–3>
R–Y
Cowl side panel LH
I15
IGNITION KEY CYLINDER LIGHT
2
G–R
1 : w/ Fade Out
2 : w/o Fade Out
3 : w/o Theft Deterrent System
4 : w/ Theft Deterrent System
3 1V
W–B
W–B
BM
Roof left
2
R–W
(*1)
R–W
From Wireless
Door Lock ECU<14–6>
D A
From Theft
Deterrent ECU
<15–2>
R–G
E A
6 IN2
E A
R–G
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
1
7 1S
1 1G
W–B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
From Theft
Deterrent ECU
<15–2>
A
A B
J 9 A , J10 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–G
R–G
From Theft
Deterrent ECU
<15–1>
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
1 F
100A
ALT
2 F
B–R
1 A
B
B–R
1 C
1 1B
1
B–R
40A
AM1
2
2 1K
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
B–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
BATTERY
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
C A
8 A (*3)
6 B (*4)
10
6
3 C
2 C
1 C
I16
IGNITION SW
ACC
IG1 4
2 AM1
B
R–G
7 1J
4 C
B–Y
B
1
W
R–G
D13
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT RH
R–G
1
E A
2
1
D7
DIODE
(Courtesy)
I18 A , B
I17 C ,
7
R–G
INTEGRATION RELAY
10A
GAUGE
R–W
D B
4 1G
4
R–W
R–G
See Taillight
System<11–1>
1
R–W
1
R–W
J33 A , J34 B
See Headlight
System<6–2><7–2>
D15
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR RH
R–W
D14
DOOR COURTESY SW
REAR LH
1
7. 5A
DOME
1 1K
8 IN2
R–W
R–W
D A
12 1S
9 1S
1 1W
12 2J
2
SHORT
PIN
R
R–W
(*2)
E B
R
8 1G
R–Y
G–R
E B
11 1H 6 1F 1 1M 2 1F
2 1M
2
5 1F
R
R
1
1 2A
R–W
(*2)
1
DOOR
I19
INTERIOR LIGHT
D A
R
From Light Failure
Sensor<11–4>
ON
OFF
R
R–W
L ig h t A u to T ur n O ff
W–B
P5
PERSONAL LIGHT
C16
CONDENSER
2
1
R
2
W–B
(w/ Moon Roof)
1
2
R
(w/ Moon Roof)
Instrument panel
brace LH
1
R
D10
DIODE
(Dome)
2
*
*
*
*
G–R
R–W
2
V8
VANITY LIGHT LH
R
P ow er S ou rc e
W–B
W–B
1
R
R
3
In te rio r L igh t
V9
VANITY LIGHT RH
R
9 CAMRY
W–B
2
W–B
1
R
3 1F
1
R
R
IE
11
E
10
R–W
E
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R
R
4
C9
OPEN DOOR WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
10 CAMRY
P o w er S ou rc e
* 1 : Separate Type Amplifier
* 2 : Built–In Type Amplifier
* 3 : Automatic A/C
Illu mina tio n
1
* 4 : Manual A/C
* 5 : w/ Daytime Running Light
* 6 : w/o Daytime Running Light
3
2
4
G
1
5
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
7. 5A
PANEL
2
A A
3
A A
A A
A A
J30 A , J31 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4 1B
6 1C
4 1J
G
1
W–B
2
G3
GLOVE BOX LIGHT AND SW
B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C10
COMBINATION METER ILLUMINATION
[COMB. METER]
R4 C
A
A
A
W–B
A A
B
W–B
B
A
3
D
A
B
8 1J
6
1V
4
1H
B
E
B
D
A
1
E
D
A
W–B
BATTERY
12
5 IH2
E
B
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
13
W–G
(*1)
A A
3
W–G
(*1)
W–G
(*2)
W–B
A
J13 A , J14 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
B
A A
16
9 C
RADIO AND PLAYER
5 B
R2 B , R3 A
3
RADIO AND PLAYER
H7
HAZARD SW
2
2 C
O2
A/T SHIFT LEVER ILLUMINATION
[O/D MAIN SW]
B
G
(*1)
G
2
B
HEAD
FL MAIN
3. 0W
1
10 A
B
(*3)
TAIL
C13
COMBINATION
SW
2
A24
ASHTRAY
ILLUMINATION
A B
12
A34
A/C CONTROL
ASSEMBLY
B
(*4)
A B
G
G
(*3)
B5
BLOWER SW
7
10 IH1
B B
G
(*4)
3
6
B
(*4)
A B
4
A14
A/C SW
A B
1
B B
G
(*4)
B–G
LIGHT
CONTROL
SW
OFF
2
B
H
C5
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
ILLUMINATION
T
2
B
(*4)
EL
To Daytime Running
Light Relay(Main)<7–3>
14
From Daytime Running
Light Relay(Main)<7–3>
1
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
6
G
G
(*4)
I17
INTEGRATION
RELAY
B B
G
B B
G
B B
B A
G
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
G
(*2)
G–Y
(*5)
G
F4 A , F9 F
1 A
B A
G–R
(*5)
2
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
100A
ALT
G
(*1)
A
G–R
(*6)
B–R
2 F
A B
G
G–R
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A B
J13 A , J14 B
A
B–R
B–R
1 F
5 1D
T
ILL
2 R7
RHEOSTAT
B
J16 A , J17 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
7 1J
W–B
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
Instrument panel
brace LH
IF
Left kick panel
J
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
5
2
W–B
R10
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
4
G–O
9
W–B
3
G–O
G–O
G
Back panel
center
W–B
W–B
A
A
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
3
5
1
R9
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
SIDE
MARKER
G
W–B
(*6)
1
G
L1
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT LH
W–B
2
G
G
(*6)
G–O
* 1 : TMC Made w/ ABS w/o Traction Control
* 2 : TMMK Made w/ ABS w/o Traction Control
* 3 : w/ ABS and Traction Control
3
W–B
1
W–B
2
1
C B
W–B
W–B
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
To Engine Control
Module<2–10>
1 1B
A
A
W–B
Instrument panel
brace LH
BATTERY
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8
1J
7
1J
HEAD
TAIL
C13
COMBINATION SW
W–B
A
F4 A , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
B–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
100A
ALT
1 A
B–R
2 F
B–R
B–R
1
16
EL
H
T
OFF
1
14
2
A
B–R
1 F
40A
AM1
2
2 1K
W
W–B
LIGHT
CONTROL SW
B–R
4 1B
7 1C
W
G–R
(*5)
I17
INTEGRATION RELAY
G
To Wireless Door
Lock ECU<14–7>
To Theft Deterrent
ECU<15–3>
15A
STOP
2 AM1
1
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
From Daytime Running Light
Relay(Main)<7–3>
G–Y
(*4)
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–R
(*4)
A
G–R A
6 1C
3
2
1
5
I16
IGNITION SW
IG1 4
ACC
To Daytime Running Light
Relay(Main)<7–3>
G–R
Left radiator
side support
1
W–B
2
G–O
EB
F1
FRONT PARKING LIGHT LH
A A
A
A
G–O
(1MZ–FE)
G–O
C B
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
F2
FRONT PARKING LIGHT RH
G–O
A
9 1C
10A
TAIL
G–O
G–O
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
2
G
J35 A , J36 B
8 1S
G
TAIL
B–Y
2
G
L2
LICENSE PLATE
LIGHT RH
W–B
BL
W–B
5
1
W–B
G–O
3
11
W–B
R11
TAILLIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
SIDE
MARKER
W–B
G
(*6)
BP
W–B
3
W–B
4
G–O
Under the left
center pillar
8
R8
TAILLIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
TAIL
T a illig ht
Back panel
center
R9
STOP LIGHT LH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT LH]
BP
W–B
W–B
G–R
5
2
2
4
5 IF2
Y–G
W–B
G–O
P ow er S ou rc e
BL
A
A
1
2
1
W–B
G
(*6)
11 CAMRY
Under the left
center pillar
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 1H
7
L3
LIGHT FAILURE SENSOR
C 8 A , C10 C
Y–G
R–L
1 1S
W–B
G–R
7 C
D
2
1D
1 1K
* 4 : w/ Daytime Running Light
* 5 : w/o Daytime Running Light
* 6 : TMC Made
W
10A
GAUGE
R–L
D
R–L
3
5 1R
G–W
(*3)
H10
HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
R
R
To Condenser
<9–3>
R11
STOP LIGHT RH
[REAR COMB. LIGHT RH]
3 A
To ABS and
Traction
ECU<18–2>
G–W
To Shift Lock ECU
<16–3>
REAR LIGHTS
WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
G–W
(*2)
G–W
G–W
J27 A , J28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
To ABS Actuator
and ECU<20–1>
C B
G–W
(*1)
C B
To ABS ECU
<19–3>
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–W
A A
1
To Engine
Control Module
<2–10><3–10>
4
S top L igh t
4 1R
G–W
2
W
2 1S
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
12 CAMRY
P o w e r S o u rc e
W ipe r a n d W a s h er
1
R em o te C o n trol M irr or
3
2
4
* 1 : TMMK Made
* 2 : TMC Made w/ Mirror Heater
* 3 : TMC Made w/o Mirror Heater
L–R
IG1 4
B–Y
L–R
ACC 3
2 AM1
1 1K
6 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
W
25A
WIPER
40A
AM1
E A
+B
+2
+1
+S
INT1
INT2
B1
EW
WF
2
M
WF
EW
WIPER RELAY
+2
2
8
+1
7
+S
LEFT
+B
16
RIGHT
UP
MH
L
L–Y
L–B
L–O
W–B
HL
LEFT/
UP
8
A
A
VR
7
B
4 2F
15 IM1
LG–R
LG–B
BR–R
1 A
3 A
2 A
1 A
3 A
2 A (*1)
4 B
2 B
3 B
4 B
2 B
3 B (*2)
3 C
1 C
2 C
3 C
1 C
2 C (*3)
A
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
4
M
M
M
M
W–B
Instrument panel
brace LH
14 IM1
A
W–B
IG
16 IM1
LG–R
W–B
E
F3
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
A
15 IE1
BR–Y
10 2J
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
14 IE1
BR–W
W–B
M
BATTERY
16 IE1
C
W–B
W–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
LG–B
S
BR–R
+1
10
C
LG–R
2
BR–Y
1
BR–W
B–G
+2
5
E
6
C
L
3
M+
LG–B
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG–R
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
1
LG–R
L
VL
BR–Y
5
L–W
1 A
RIGHT/
DOWN
MV
HR
BR–R
F4 A , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
6 IK1
DOWN
17
SELECT
SW
L–W
B–R
B–R
11
R6
REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR SW
9
B
WASHER
OPERATION
SW
W2
WASHER
MOTOR
B–R
100A
ALT
P–L
V
LO
L
L
2
1
2 F
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
E B
HI
1 F
A
OFF
INT
1
1 1B
1 1T
P–L
2
C11
WIPER AND WASHER SW
[COMB. SW]
L
J35 A , J36 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2 1K
1 1A
To Wireless Door
Lock ECU<14–7>
4 1C
15A
CIG
Left radiator
side support
EB
R16 A , B , C
R17 A , B , C
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH
REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH
IF
Left kick
panel
J
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
100A ALT
J33 A , J34 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
(*3)
B–G
Cowl side
panel LH
W–B
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
2
R
UP
G
L–W
See Light Auto Turn Off
System<9–1>
INTEGRATION
RELAY
I18 A , B
F4 A , F9 F
M
P11
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
FRONT RH
1
2
1
5
D
R
UP
G
M
P12
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR LH
1
U
3
1
U
2
5
D
1
4
SD
2
SU
M
P13
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
REAR RH
B
3 BP1
2 BP1
G
W–B(*4)
G
P10
POWER WINDOW MOTOR
FRONT LH
2
R
1
B
4
SD
2
SU
UP
W–B
W–B
IE
M
L
3
U
D
G–W
R
IG
1
B
3
G–B
2
G–Y
SD
R–B
5
3 BO1
G–B
SU
1 BP1
R–Y
2 BO1
7 IN2
5 IN2
G–B
3 1V
4
1 BO1
5 IM2
4 IM2
DOWN
R–L
L
L
DOWN
L
5 IF1
12 IE2
6 IE2
13
RRD
DOWN
Instrument panel
brace LH
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
6 IM2
DOWN
L
L
DOWN
L
1 IF1
9 IE2
7 IE2
8
RRU
DOWN
BATTERY
L–W
R–B
7 1G
W–B
(*3)
R–B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
UP
L
20 IE1
NORMAL
WINDOW LOCK SW
A
UP
9
IN2
11 IE2
G–W
W–B
(*4)
LOCK
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
L A
5 IE2
R–L
W–B
(*4)
5
G–Y
A
A
DD
1
G
DU
R–Y
1 A
W–B
W–B
(*3)
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
4
E
12
RLD
G–B
A A
L
C B
3
E
9
RLU
REAR RH
R–B
2 F
6 B
13 1G
L
3 1S
UP
7 1J
G–W
7 1S
1 1D
R–L
13 A (* 1)
1 B (* 2)
6
PD
G–Y
8 A
10
14
PU
REAR LH
R–Y
B–R
10A GAUGE
6
(*2) 3 B
3
FRONT RH
P9
POWER WINDOW MASTER SW
G–B
1 1B
R–B
1
7
2
POWER
RELAY
BW
4
1 : w/o Theft Deterrent System
2 : w/ Theft Deterrent System
3 : TMC Made
4 : TMMK Made
UP
(*1)12 A
5
11
3
*
*
*
*
R–B
1 F
W
40A
AM1
1
BW
B
L(*4)
2
10
B
B
L(*3)
FRONT LH
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
10 IE2
L(*3)
2
30A
POWER
12 1G
L(*4)
2 1K
25A
DOOR
1
5 1G 4 1B
L
L(*3)
1 1K
IG1 4 B–Y
ACC
R–B
2
P o w er W in do w
L(*4)
I16
IGNITION SW
1
B–R
2 AM1
P o w er S ou rc e
13 CAMRY
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
P8
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR RH
P7
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW REAR LH
P6
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SW FRONT RH
DOWN
R
MEMO
L–W
B–R
SHORT PIN
B
B–R
B–R
J33 A , J34 B
25A DOOR
W–B
(*3)
B–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
IE
Cowl side
panel LH
W–B
(*3)
7
1G
W–B
(*4)
W–B
(*4)
(*3)
20 IM1
W–B
(*3)
20 IE1
W–B
(*4)
W–B
W–B
IJ
W–B
(*4)
W–B
(*3)
Right kick panel
W–B
(*4)
Instrument panel
brace LH
A
W–B
(*4)
3
1V
W–B
(*3)
W–B
D18
DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SW RH
G
UNLOCK
W–B(*3)
LOCK
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
(*3)
2
W–B(*4)
M
3
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
4
11 IE1
8 IE2
3 IE2
L–R
From Theft
Deterrent
ECU<15–2>
L–R
BL
D19
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT LH
IG
P9
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SW LH
[POWER WINDOW MASTER SW]
G
W–B
UNLOCK
(*4)
W–B
(*3)
LG
LOCK
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
LG
A
F
F
F
7 A
W–B
6
BO1
M
3
Under the left
center pillar
A
2
4
1
4 BO1
7 BO1
L–Y
5 BO1
6
IF2
7
IF2
L–B
L–B
(*1)
L–B
L–R
L–R
L–R
2 IF2
25 B
6 A
12 B
B
B
C
A
C
B
B
A
L–Y
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J30 A , J31 B
C
B
B
A
B
A
B
B
L–B
L–B
L–R
L–R
4
1
IN2
2
IN2
7 B
10 A
1 : w/o Theft Deterrent System
2 : w/ Theft Deterrent System
3 : TMC Made
4 : TMMK Made
C
A
C
A
*
*
*
*
W–B(* 4)
W–B(* 3)
L–Y
L–B
L–B
L–R
L–R
Y
L–Y
L–R
L–W
R–G
11 A (*1)
9 B (*2)
R–Y
M
L
K
J
I
H
G
F
E
D
C
B
A
(Cont. next page)
L–Y
BATTERY
A
UNLOCK
W–B
(*3)
L–R
F9 F
From Theft
Deterrent
ECU<15–2>
W–B
(*4)
J39
JUNCTION A
W–BCONNECTOR
D16
DOOR KEY LOCK
AND UNLOCK SW
FRONT LH
L–W
LOCK
A
L–W
A
L–R
A
1
3
L(*2)
L–B
A
2
L(*2)
L–R
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
R–G
W–B
(*4)
1
2
F
7 1S
6 B
8 A
See Light Auto Turn
Off System<9–1>
6
9 A (*1)
5 B (*2)
3
L–R
L–R
F4 A , F6 C ,
3
3
4 IM1
L–B(*1)
L–B
100A
ALT
LG
D17
DOOR KEY LOCK
AND UNLOCK SW
FRONT RH
L
UNLOCK
2 F
4
LG
5
From Theft
Deterrent
ECU<15–2>
6
3 IM1
L–W
7
R–G
4 IE1
L–W
3 IE1
A
L
2
12 IM1
B
L–W
J37
JUNCTION
ACONNECTOR
B
11 B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 F
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G
13 IM1
B
B
B
A
R–G
From Theft
Deterrent
ECU<15–2>
4 1B
LG
G
12 IE1
B
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
13 IE1
E
B
B
5 A
20 B
L
L–R
L–Y
1 A
7. 5A DOME
D
B
R–G
3 A
18 B
L–W
D
R–G
1 1D
E
G
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
E
4 A
19 B
I18 A , B
INTEGRATION RELAY
R–Y
L–B
1 C
L–W
See Key Reminder and
Seat Belt Warning
System<21–3>
5 1M
5
2
L–W
L
1 2A
D
2 A (*1)
17 B (*2)
R–G
C B
1 A
16 B
8
1G
L–R
A A
7 1J
10
1
1W
L–R
1
13 A (*1)
1 B (*2)
1
D o o r L o c k C o n trol
L–B
2
12 2J
R
P ow e r S o urc e
14 CAMRY
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
Y
D21
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW REAR LH
W–B
W–B
(*4)
W–B
LOCK
14 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
W ire le s s D oo r L o ck C on trol
5
A
R–Y
1
2
E A
From Remote Control
Mirror SW<12–3>
V
1
G–R
E B
E B
D A
B A
J33 A , J34 B
D A
G–R
L–R
D A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J 9 A , J10 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
L–Y
C
4
L–Y
Y C
L–R
9
B B
J37
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
Y
10
13
L–Y
From Theft
Deterrent ECU
<15–2>
G
5
12
L–Y
C
F
L–B
11
14
LG
W6
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK ECU
8
R–W
7
Y
E
L–R
To Theft Deterrent
ECU<15–4>
To Door Courtesy SW
Front RH, Rear RH
<9–2>
L–W
15
D
8
R
R–G
To Unlock Warning SW
<21–3>
J16 A , J17 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D B
C
7
6
R
D10
DIODE
(Dome)
B
* 3 : TMC Made
* 4 : TMMK Made
L–Y
H
M
4
From TAILLIGHT
Relay<11–1>
1
From Theft Deterrent
ECU<15–3>
D22
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW REAR RH
1 (*3)
4 (*4)
3
L–Y
M
2
4 BP1
L–B
4 (*3)
1 (*4)
7 BP1
L–R
3
D20
DOOR LOCK MOTOR AND
DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SW FRONT RH
2
5 BP1
Y
L–B
L–R
L–Y
11 IM1
W–B
3 IM2
3
IN2
L–Y
G–R
7 IM2
K
10 IG1
L–B
L–B
Y
J
L–B
L–Y
I
L–R
A
W–B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B(*4)
W–B
Right kick panel
IK
W–B
M
A
6 BP1
W–B(*3)
W–B
L
BN
Under the right
center pillar
Left kick panel
IF
J
1
2
2 IF1
Back panel
center
BP
J33
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
C
LUG
7 A
Left radiator
side support
IF
A
A
6 IF1
To Door Unlock Detection
SW Rear LH, RH<14–6>
Y
To Door Unlock Detection
SW Front RH<14–5>
L
To Door Key Lock and
Unlock SW Front RH
<14–3>
L–W
To Door Key Lock and
Unlock SW Front
LH, RH<14–2>
R–G
To Door Key Lock and
Unlock SW Front LH
<14–2>
L–R
To Door Unlock Detection
SW Front LH<14–3>
R–G
To Door Courtesy SW
Front RH<9–1>
R–W
To Door Courtesy SW
Front RH, Rear RH
<9–2>
R–G
To Door Courtesy SW
Front LH<9–1>
L–B
To Unlock Warning
SW<21–3>
2 F
B
FL MAIN
3. 0W
1 A
25A DOOR
B–G
BATTERY
100A ALT
1 F
B–R
1 C
L–W
EB
Left kick
panel
5
9
E A
D B
D B
L–Y
B–R
B–R
B–R
IH
Instrument panel
brace RH
2
3 IK1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
1 IG3
From Engine
Control
Module
<2–9><3–9>
R–Y
J 9 A , J10 B
3 A
DSWH
IND
E
7 B
2 A
DSWL
LSWR
16 A
LSWP
To Luggage Compartment
Light SW<9–4>
15 A
UL2
R–Y
10 A
L2
R–Y
8 A
UL3
W–B
9 A
LSWD
KSW
W–B
14 A
DSWD
IG
13 A
A B
1 1B
B–R
4 1B
1
2
2 1K
BR
R–Y
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
40A
AM1
I16
IGNITION SW
IG1 4
W
B–R
J16 A , J17 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 1D
1
2 AM1
ACC
15A ECU–IG
C A
8 1D
1 1K
B–Y
CTY
DSWP
L–W
+B2
L–W
1 B
C
C
J34
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8 1G
1 1W
12 2J
2
1
1 2A
B
2
7. 5A DOME
B–R
C10
THEFT DETERRENT
INDICATOR LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
5 A
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–Y
SHORT PIN
R
R–Y
W–B
1 A
J16 A , J17 B
T 3 B , T 4 A THEFT DETERRENT ECU
9 B
SH
+B1
R
11 A
W–L
D B
E A
2
D10
DIODE
(Dome)
1
5 IG3
4 IK1
1
2
3 2F
W–L
B
4 A
TAIL
G–R
11 B
G–R
W–L
B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
10A
HORN
W
B
J33
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
10 IG1
G–R
From TAILLIGHT
Relay<11–1>
6 B
R–B
3
T h eft D e te rren t
G–W
6 A
R–B
PANI
18 A
From HEAD Relay(*1)<6–2>
From Daytime Running Light
Relay(Main)(*2)<7–1>
HORN
12 B
G–B
T1
THEFT DETERRENT
HORN
R
P o w e r S o ur ce
G–W
E6
ENGINE HOOD
COURTESY SW
HEAD
11 IG1
G–B
7 IG3
From HORN Relay
<21–4>
10 B
LG
From Wireless Door
Lock ECU<14–6>
15 CAMRY
L4
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
KEY UNLOCK SW
G–W
W–B
4
* 1 : w/o Daytime Running Light
* 2 : w/ Daytime Running Light
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
16 CAMRY
P ow er S ou rc e
Power
O u tlet
S h ift L o c k
1
2
C ig are tte L ig h te r an d C loc k
3
G
4
R
L–R
IG1 4
B–Y
R
ACC 3
1 1K
G
L–R
2 AM1
W
1 1W
6 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
W
R
2 1K
12 2J
15A
POWER–
OUTLET
8 1D
G–W
C
SLS–
SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID
1
2
L
V
1
1 1B
1 2A
L–B
1
2
1
D B
3
1
4
2
C6
CLOCK
S3
SHIFT LOCK ECU
4
W–B
W–B
W–B
W–B
8 1J
W–B
5 IG1
4 1V
L–B
A
2
A
7 1J
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
W–B
A
W–B
Left kick
panel
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A
W–B
IF
A
J7
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BATTERY
3 1V
A
1
W–B
A
W–B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
K3
KEY INTERLOCK
SOLENOID
B–G
FL MAIN
3. 0W
2
KLS+
5
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
1 A
1 C
2
G
E A
R
G
P
G–R 3
C4
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
B
B–R
B–R
See Taillight
System<11–1>
100A
ALT
A B
G–W 1
P4
POWER OUTLET
P1
2 F
A
P–L
P2
E
1 F
A A
A
SHIFT LOCK
CONTROL SW
B–R
B–R
B–R
A
J16 A , J17 B
SHORT
PIN
P–L
40A AM1
4 1B
2
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
STP SLS+
J6
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
TAILLIGHT
RELAY
6 1C
ACC
5
1
1 1T
L–R
2
1
6 1J
J30 A , J31 B
IG
2
1
6
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
3
5 1J
1
P–L
2
From Stop Light SW
<11–4>
R
3
8 1G
15A
CIG
D10
DIODE
(Dome)
C
P–L
7. 5A
DOME
B–R
B–R
7. 5A
PANEL
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–Y
G
5 1D
15A
ECU–IG
IE
A
Cowl side
panel LH
IG
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Instrument panel
brace LH
IF
Left kick panel
J
W
15A
STOP
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
R–L
O
F4 A , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
D
B–G
D
D
4
J2
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
O
J7 A , J8 B
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
W
CRUISE
LG–R
O
W–B
3 C12
CRUISE CONTROL SW
[COMB. SW]
W–B
IG
A
7 1J
8 1J
W–B
CANCEL
A A
Instrument panel
brace LH
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A A
To Engine Control Module
<4–3><5–3>
SET/
COAST
A A
W–B
M
1
15
MO
R–G
RESUME/
ACCEL
CMS CCS
A B
16
GND
2
7
MC
4
3
SPD
12
R–Y
L
2
STP–
8
4
1
2
5 1R
4 1R
A A
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J27 A
A A
R–Y
EP
5
10
CCS
OD
14
3
G–W
BATTERY
C10
CRUISE CONTROL INDICATOR
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
O
W–L
FL MAIN
3. 0W
11
CMS
IDL
13
W–B
5 IG2
5
B–R
4
TC
6
L–R
ECT
G–B
G–W
10
PI
C15
CRUISE CONTROL ECU
V–W
D
3
P1
D POSITION SW
[PARK/NEUTRAL
POSITION SW]
4
* 1 : 1MZ–FE A/T
* 2 : 5S–FE A/T
W
1 A
R–L
7
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
100A
ALT
J12
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B–R
B
A
B–R
C14
CRUISE CONTROL
CLUTCH SW
A
9 II2
10
2
L–B
(A/T)
9
B–R
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
(M/T)
A
D
Y–B
(A/T)
2 F
2
A
A
A
A
J21
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
C
R–L
(M/T)
1
2 II2
R–L
(*2)
C
9 1J
15A
ECU–IG
D A
F B
To Electronically
Controlled Transmission
Solenoid<4–2><5–2>
D
10A
GAUGE
1 1J
F B
J24
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
D
2 1D
1 1K
J27 A , J28 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
To Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]<25–8>
1 F
B–Y
R–L
(*1)
1 1B
40A
AM1
I16
IGNITION SW
IG1 4
ACC
R–L
(A/T)
R–L
(*2)
1
2
2 1K
2 AM1
R–L
2W
C ru is e C on trol
R–L
(*1)
4 1B
7 1C
W
1
P ow e r S o urc e
17 CAMRY
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
S6
STOP LIGHT SW
G–W
C3
CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
R–B
W–B
To Data Link
Connector 1, 2
<18–4><19–3><20–3>
To Data Link
Connector 2
<18–4><19–3><20–2>
18 CAMRY
P ow e r S o urc e
A B S an d T rac tion C on tro l
1
* 1 : TMC Made
* 2 : TMMK Made
3
2
4
R–L
8 IK2
GR–L
IG1 4 B–Y
3
O
BR
2 IK1
B B
MR
23 A
9 A
TS
TC
SR
R–L
24 A 11 A
R+
LG–R
R–Y
GR
GR–L
1 A
MT
22 A
D/G
W–B
1 IL1
II3
A
A
W–B
BR
1
J22
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A26
ABS SPEED
SENSOR
REAR RH
2
BR
(Shielded)
B(*1)
L(*2)
W(*1)
P(*2)
1
(*2)
2
2
A25
ABS SPEED
SENSOR
REAR LH
1
BR
3 IL1
(Shielded)
G(*1)
BR(*2)
J8 B
2
9 ID1
R(*1)
Y(*2)
J7 A ,
1
A10
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
A A
(*2)
A B
2 IL1
W–B
3 ID1
6
G
W–B
(*2)
A B
A9
ABS SPEED SENSOR
R FRONT LH
W–B
(*2)
W–B
1
4 ID1
6 IK2
W–B
1 IK2
W–B
W–B
(*2)
RR– GND3 GND2 GND1
10 B
9 C 10 C 15 A
B
4
RR+
9 B
W
RL–
1 B
G
B
W
G
R
RL+
2 B
R
FL–
FR+
FR–
4 A 17 A 18 A
W–B
(*2)
W–B
Instrument
panel brace LH
A
GR–R
R–W
R
LG–B
14 A
AST
LG
T5
TRACTION OFF SW
From Stop Light
SW<11–4>
8 1J
W–B
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
C
10 A
FL+
5 A
7 1J
C
L C
12 A
CSW
11 B
A B
L
BATTERY
25 A
ABS AND TRACTION ECU
G–W
To Engine
Control
Module<2–8>
G–B
7 C
SFLR SRRH SRRR SRLH SRLR
L
LG
B
W
BR–W
L
G–B
G–B
L
B–G
C
8 C
G–Y
1 C
R–G
2 C
W–R
W–L
L–B
W–R
R–B
Y–B
Y–R
B–Y
6 C 13 A 26 A
WA
WT
NEO EFI+ EFI– TRC+ TRC– STP
4 B 12 B 15 B 6 B 14 B 13 B
5 B 16 B
LG
18 IG3
4 C 12 C
J8 B
12 IK2
C A
J7 A ,
J3
B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B
L
3 B
17
R–L
5 B
B
3
ABS TRC
14
LG–R
4 A
B
LG–R
10 A
MT
P–B
5 A
LG–R
11 A
II3
B
4
LG–R
6 A
11
R–Y
12 A
From Airbag Sensor
Assembly<28–4>
8 II3
LG–R(*1)
P–B(*2)
R–Y
3 A
A15 A , A16 B , A17 C
IND
3 B
C
EA
LG(* 1)
B–Y(*2)
9 A
SRRH SRRR SRLH SRLR AST
TC
11
5 II3
G–B
1 A
SRC1 SRC2 SMC1 SMC2 SFRH SFRR SFLH
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
Right radiator
side support
BM
E1
TC
16
G–B
8 A
G–B
LG
12 IG3
5 C
IG1
5 A
19 IG3
B–R
B–R
8 B
C
FL MAIN
3. 0W
W–R
W–L
W–B
2 A
SFLR
F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
TS
22
M
SRC1 SRC2 SMC1 SMC2 SFRH SFRR SFLH
SLIP
4 C
R–L
F4 A , F5 B ,
ABS
1 A
BS
10
A/D
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
WA
2 B
D4
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
5 IK2
L
100A ALT
3 C
GR–R
4 B
GND
7 C
TRAC
OFF
2 F
3
5
AB
R–L
B–R
B–R
1 F
A7 A , A8 B
C
B–G
1 B
3
C
7 A
C 8 A , C10 C
COMBINATION
METER
3
GR–R
ABS AND TRACTION
ACTUATOR
1 B
B–R
B–R
D
3
W–B
9 1J
D
3
(Short Pin)
W–B
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 1B
2
4
23
R–L(*1)
Y–B(*2)
3
R–L
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
4 II3
WB
2 1D
1
4
ABS
MOTOR
RELAY
3
15A ECU–IG
10A GAUGE
60A
FL ABS
40A
AM1
1
ABS SOL
RELAY
W
1 1K
2
1
6
2
I16
IGNITION SW
2 1K
2
5
From Cruise Control
ECU<17–2>
1
From Cruise
Control ECU<17–2>
3
R–L
2 AM1
3
From Airbag Sensor
Assembly<28–4>
GR
ACC
EA
EC
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
IG
Right radiator
side support
Surge
tank
RH
J
W
B–R
GR–L
W–B
GR–L
W–R
B–R
B–G
B–R
W–R
R–B
60A FL ABS
B–G
SFRR SFLH
R–B
SFRH
W–R
SRLH
4 A
6 B
BS
SRLR MT
3 A
A4 A , A5 B
E
W–B
W–R
Right radiator
side support
1 A
W–B
IG
2
W–B
Instrument panel
brace LH
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
A25
ABS SPEED
SENSOR
REAR LH
1
2
A26
ABS SPEED
SENSOR
REAR RH
1
2 IL1
1 IL1
3 ID1
9 ID1
10 B
23 B
RR+
FR+
3 A
22 B
RR–
FR–
9 A
C A
II3
Surge tank RH
(1MZ–FE)
Intake manifold
(5S–FE)
EC
J22(1MZ–FE) A
J23(5S–FE)
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR A
6
J7 A , J8 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B B
BR
EA
A
W–B
2 A
RL+
FL+
8 A
9 B
RL–
FL–
2 A
STP
5 B
G
BM
M
ABS ACTUATOR
12 B
GND
ABS ECU
W–B
25 B
GND2
D/G
24 B
R
W–R
2 B
SRRH SRRR
8 B
TC
8 B
A10
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
1
2
B
W–B
W–L
SFLR
4 B
L–B
7 B
W–L
3 B
G–Y
5 B
10 A
MT
R–W
1 B
5 IK2
LG–B
13 IK2
14 B
15 B
G–Y
12 IK2
11 A
W–R
6 A
SRLR
LG–B
11 IK2
12 A
R–G
5 A
SRLH
TS
LG–R
W
BATTERY
ABS MOTOR RELAY
W–L
BR
FL MAIN
3. 0W
GR
G
F9 F
GR
R
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
ABS SOL RELAY
B
F4 A , F5 B ,
GR–R
W
1 A
R–L
1 B
C10
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
2 B
G–B
100A
ALT
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
R–L
SFLR SRRH SRRR
G–B
SFRR SFLH
R–Y
SFRH
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
G–B
21 B
G–W
WA
LG–R
11 B
A18 A , A19 B
1 IK2
6 IK2
G
IG1
LG–R
1 B
B–R
13 B
P–B
LG–R
R
R+
R–L
26 B
B
B
From Cruise Control
ECU<17–2>
From Airbag Sensor
Assembly<28–4>
SR
B–R
J3
JUNCTION B
CONNECTOR
B
B
From Stop Light
SW<11–4>
7 A
C
C
ABS
14
G
12 IG3
C
11 II3
8 II3
TC
4
A9
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
1
2
B
MR
4
7
5 II3
TC
11
3
A/D E1
10
BR
W
1 A
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 IK1
D
D
TS
16
D4
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
R
2 F
3
10A GAUGE
3
C
C
G–B
3
5
22
WA
R–Y
3
6
4
2 1D
AB
5
LG–R
3
3
1
9 1J
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
From Cruise Control
ECU<17–2>
4
BR
1 F
3
4
2
15A ECU–IG
2
3
R–L
3
(Short Pin)
1
1
3
R–L
1 1B
2
3
WB
23
4 II3
From Airbag Sensor
Assembly<28–4>
3
BR
1
40A
AM1
GR–R
1 1K
2
R–L
LG
2
GR–R
B–Y
8
IK2
A B S (T M C M a de )
O
2 1K
IG1 4
1
B–Y
I16
IGNITION SW
2 AM1
ACC
P o w er S ou rc e
19 CAMRY
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
20 CAMRY
A B S (T M M K M a d e)
P o w e r S o u rc e
1
3
2
4
From Cruise
Control ECU<17–2>
O
ACC
B–Y
D4
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 2
1 1K
B–G
A/D
1
W
ABS
5
TS
16
II3
R–Y
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
J7 A , J8 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
B
BR
A
B
From Airbag Sensor
Assembly<28–4>
8
LG
B–Y(1MZ–FE)
LG(5S–FE)
II3
5 IK2
BR
R–Y
LG–R
11
TC
TS
A6
ABS ACTUATOR AND ECU
2 F
FL+
FL–
FR+
FR–
GND1
GND2
RL+
RL–
RR+
RR–
7
6
5
4
19
16
9
8
2
1
1 IK2
6 IK2
13 IK2
3 IK3
(Shielded)
9 IK3
7 IK3
2 IK3
6 IK3
BR
L
P
(Shielded)
J22(1MZ–FE)
J23(5S–FE)
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
(Shielded)
B
W
G
R
(Shielded)
8 IK3
BR
Y
FL MAIN
3. 0W
W–B
B–G
F9 F
6 II3
L
W–B
P
(Shielded)
BR
Y
W–B
W–B
(Shielded)
W–B
G
R
(Shielded)
F4 A , F5 B ,
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
11
BR
12
TC
11
LG–R
12 IK2
WA
AB
LG–R
B
21
IG1
P–B
B
10 IK3
15
+B
B
LG–R
C
B
R–L
17
B
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
12 IG3
R–L
100A
ALT
1 A
5 IK3
R–L
B–R
B–R
+B
4
C
R–L
18
STP
7
C
C
B–R
B–G
14
1 F
L
B–R
G–W
1 1B
L
1 IK3
C10
ABS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
1
D
C
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
B–R
3
G–W
40A
AM1
1 B
D
From Stop Light
SW<11–4>
J4
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
R–L
2
9 1J
LG–R
BR
2 1D
2
4
3
R–L
60A
FL ABS
2 1K
TC
E1
14
D1
DATA LINK
CONNECTOR 1
P–B(1MZ–FE)
LG–R(5S–FE)
15A ECU–IG
10A GAUGE
3
I16
IGNITION SW
10
From Cruise Control
ECU<17–2>
IG1 4
From Airbag sensor
Assembly<28–4>
2 AM1
(Shielded)
A
3 ID1
9 ID1
4 ID1
3 IL1
2 IL1
1 IL1
A
L
(Shielded)
P
Y
W–B
BR
BATTERY
(Shielded)
BR
2
1
A9
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT LH
2
1
1
A10
ABS SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
2
A25
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR LH
Right radiator
side support
EA
1
2
A26
ABS SPEED SENSOR
REAR RH
Surge tank RH
(1MZ–FE)
Intake Manifold
(5S–FE)
EC
J
21 CAMRY
W
1 1B
B–R
B–R
B
B–G
W–B
W–B
L–B
W–B
W–B
From
Wireless
Door Lock
ECU<14–6>
J 9 A , J10 B
L
W–B
(*3)
W–B
W–B
From
Engine
Control
Module
<2–9><3–9>
2
W–B
(*1)
Under the
left center
pillar
1 BQ1
W–B
(*1)
IG
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
L–B
B B
B A
A
BL
A
2
1
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
(*2)
Instrument panel
brace LH
B B
B A
B7
BUCKLE SW LH
Roof left
POWER RELAY
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
A
W–B
2
1
L–B
1
B6
BUCKLE SW LH
BM
W–B
A , B
3 BQ1
R–Y(*1)
4 1S
8
6
1
7 1S
1
1 1W
To Theft Deterrent ECU
<15–3>
IE
3
1F
M4
From Theft
Deterrent
ECU
<15–1>
L–B
Cowl side
panel LH
3
1V
NO. 3
R–Y
(*1)
3 B (* 4)
7 1D
L–B
5 1M
7
R–Y
(*2)
MOON ROOF MOTOR
AND LIMIT SW
NO. 2
3 A (* 3)
3 1M
J33 A , J34 B
7 1J
INTEGRATION
RELAY
5 1F
C
6
C
C
3
5
H5
HORN
(High)
1
1 2F
HORN
RELAY
H o rn
G–W
BATTERY
B–R
7 1F
9
I18 A , B
G–B
4 A
G
1 B (*4)
5
6 B (*6)
3 1T
7. 5A DOME
M
6 B
10
1 B
8 A (*5)
4 A
10 2K
2
1
10A
HORN
4
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
FL MAIN
3. 0W
2 B
5 B
NO. 1
4 B
2
3 B
13 A
L–W
3
30A POWER
1
R–B
12 A
See Light Auto
Turn Off
System<9–1>
5
2
10A GAUGE
2 A (*3)
1
MTR–
12 2J
2
1
1 2A
G–B
1 A
1 A
P–B
(*4)
G–W
5 A
R–L
R
6 A
5
7 C
SEAT BELT WARNING
J4
LIGHT[COMB. METER]
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–L
R–L
R–W
100A
ALT
3
LS#1 MTR+
A A
C B
C 8 A , C10 C
2 F
7
LS#2
1
5 1G
D
D
2 1D
R
(*4)
1 F
8
LS#3
IG
4
1 1D
25A
DOOR
1 1K
R
1 C
2
G
B
L
4 1B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–R
B–R
6
R
(*4)
L–W
1
40A
AM1
1 : w/ Power Seat
2 : w/o Power Seat
3 : TMC Made
4 : TMMK Made
5 : w/o Theft Deterrent System
6 : w/ Theft Deterrent System
M3
MOON ROOF CONTROL SW AND
RELAY
*
*
*
*
*
*
3
K e y R e m ind e r a nd S e a t B e lt W a rning
SHORT PIN
2
2 1K
B–R
R(*4)
2
B–R
I16
IGNITION SW
IG1 4
ACC
B
B–Y
M oon Roof
B
2 AM1
1
P ow e r S ou rc e
1
H6
HORN
(Low)
G–W
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
C12
HORN SW
[COMB. SW]
G–B
D12
DOOR COURTESY SW
FRONT LH
R–G
U1
UNLOCK WARNING SW
W–B
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
22 CAMRY
P o w er S ou rc e
P o w er S ea t
1
* 1 : TMC Made
* 2 : TMMK Made
3
2
4
L–W
L–W
L–W
A A
A A
J 9 A , J10 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
8 IF1
C B
4
IN2
L–W
L–W
3 1D
L–W
2
2 BQ1
2 BR1
30A
POWER
L–W
L–W
1
4 1B
P14 A , B
POWER SEAT CONTROL SW
(Driver’ s Seat)
11 A (*1)
2 B (*2)
P15 A , B
POWER SEAT CONTROL SW
(Front Passenger’ s Seat)
11 A (*1)
2 B (*2)
B–R
DOWN
UP
3 A
2 A
6 B
8 B
5 B
R–B
(*1)
L–Y
(*1)
W–B
2
M
R
(*2)
2
P20
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(Front Passenger’ s Seat
Rear Vertical Control)
M
L–Y
(*2)
1
1
R–B
(*2)
M
P21
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(Front Passenger’ s Seat
Reclining Control)
2
7 A (*1)
4 B (*2)
R
(*1)
5 A
12 B
R–G
(*2)
1
REAR
1 A
7 B
R–G
(*1)
4 A
L–B
(*2)
L
(*2)
M
8 A
P22
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(Front Passenger’ s Seat
Slide Control)
2
R
(*2)
2
P16
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(Driver’ s Seat
Rear Vertical Control)
L–Y
(*2)
M
R–B
(*2)
P17
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(Driver’ s Seat
Reclining Control)
R–G
(*2)
L–B
(*2)
1
1
FRONT
L–Y
(*1)
L–B
(*1)
L
(*2)
B–G
P18
POWER SEAT MOTOR
(Driver’ s Seat
Slide Control)
W–B
M
REAR
VERTICAL
RECLINING
11 B
L–B
(*1)
5 B
REAR
2 A
6 B
SLIDE
L
(*1)
5 A
12 B
2
FRONT
1 A
7 B
R
(*1)
4 A
R–G
(*1)
8 A
11 B
R–B
(*1)
3 A (*1)
8 B (*2)
4 B
1 A
DOWN
UP
REAR
FRONT
REAR
VERTICAL
RECLINING
7 A
L
(*1)
F4 A , F9 B
100A
ALT
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
2 F
REAR
FRONT
B–R
B–R
1 F
SLIDE
1
FL MAIN
3. 0W
1 BQ1
1 BR1
2
5
6
1
4
3
2
5
6
1
4
W–B
3
W–B
BATTERY
P19
POWER SEAT MOTORS
(Driver’ s Seat)
A
P23
POWER SEAT MOTORS
(Front Passenger’ s Seat)
BL
Under the left
center pillar
W–B
Right kick
panel
IK
Under
the right
center
pillar
W–B
J40
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
BN
J
L–Y
20A
RADIO NO. 1
B–R
B–R
B
Instrument panel
brace RH
7 IH1
100A ALT
B–G
1
1
BR
IH
B
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
2
Y
2
4 IF1
10 IF1
3 IF1
B
R
9 IF1
3 IH2
1 IH2
6 IH2
2 IH2
BR
Y
W
BATTERY
RR–
10 A
RR+
3 A
RL–
11 A
B
R
FL MAIN
3. 0W
40A AM1
Y
W
1 A
GR
R
4 A
7. 5A RAD–NO. 2
W
10 B
RL+
L–Y
E
V
2 F
RRIN
14 B
RLIN
13 B
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
S4 A , S5 B
LG
1 F
P
FR+
G
1 A
Y
FR–
11 B
BEEP SGND
4 B
R
8 A
W
FL+
FRIN
6 B
B
2 A
FR
7
FL
FLIN
5 B
6
L
FL–
GND
12
MUTE
12 B
5
MUTE
BR
9 A
BEEP
13
GND
GND
13 A
11
GR
+B
RL
14
R4
RADIO AND PLAYER
(Shielded)
7 A
1 IH1
5 IH1
2 IH1
15
RR
ANT+B
8
1 B
1
RACC AMP+
9 B
3
ACC AMP+B
W
1 C
GR
L
6 IH1
L–Y
LG
4 IH1
9 IM1
1 IM1
8 IH1
R
ACC
2
3
+B
R+B
3 B
4
B
2 B
1
V
3 IH1
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
F13
FRONT TWEETER
(Speaker)RH
2
P
1 1B
J16
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
GR
1
L–Y
L
9 IE1
2
P
LG
1 IE1
V
B
B
1
P
A
A
1
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
L
1 2A
W
LG
2
2
F12
FRONT TWEETER
(Speaker)LH
V
R–B
(*1)
2 1K
6 1G
5 1W
F10
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
L
3 1H
6 1K
L–R
L–Y
B–R
(* 1)
11 2K
IG1
ACC 3
2
R ad io a nd P la y e r (S ep ar ate T yp e A m plifie r)
To Auto Antenna
Motor and Relay
<24–2>
I16
IGNITION SW
2 AM1
1
P o w er S ou rc e
23 CAMRY
4
* 1 : w/ Auto Antenna
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
(Shielded)
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
24 CAMRY
P o w e r S o u rce
1
2 AM1
R ad io an d P lay e r (B u ilt– In T y pe A m p lifier )
A u to A n te n na
3
2
ACC 3
L–R
IG1 4
B–Y
4
* 1 : Separate Type Amplifier
* 2 : Built–In Type Amplifier
* 3 : w/ Auto Antenna
B
W
I16
IGNITION SW
1 2A
6 1K
20A
RADIO NO. 1
2 1K
1 1K
7. 5A
RAD–NO. 2
15A
ECU–IG
2
3 1H
8 1D
GR
B–R
(*3)
B
11 2K
L–Y
40A
AM1
L–Y(*2)
1
5 1W
GR(*2)
1 1B
ANT+B
C A
J16 A , J17 B
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B B
F4 A , F6 B ,
FR+
FR–
1 A
5 A
RL+
RL–
2 B
6 B
RR+
RR–
1 B
3 B
GND
7 A
BR
R
W
3 IF1
10 IF1
4 IF1
R
B
9 IF1
Y
L
Y
1 IM1
1 IE1
B
L
9 IM1
9 IE1
LG
LG
3 IN1
FL–
6 A
V
4 IN1
RADIO AND PLAYER
+B
V
5 IN1
ACC
P
B–R
(* 3)
1 A
GR
(* 3)
F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
FL+
2 A
A B
L–Y
(* 3)
100A
ALT
C B
4 A
B–R
(*2 *3)
A A
B–R
(*1 *3)
A A
L–Y
(*2)
B–R
(*3)
GR
(*2)
GR
L–Y
(*2)
L–Y
B–R
B–R
B A
2 F
3 A
R2 B , R3 A
8 A
B A
1 F
B–R(*2 *3)
GR
(*2)
From
Radio and
Player
<23–3>
B–R
6 1G
1 IN1
1 C
2
5
ACC
IG
B–R
(*3)
B–R
(*3)
+B
GR
(*3)
L–Y
(*3)
B
B–G
3
4
ANT
W
P
FL MAIN
3. 0W
E
A27
AUTO ANTENNA MOTOR AND RELAY
6
2
W–B
F10
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER LH
BATTERY
W–B
IK
BN
1
2
F11
FRONT DOOR
SPEAKER RH
1
2
R12
REAR SPEAKER
LH
1
2
R13
REAR SPEAKER
RH
BR
W–B
Right kick
panel
1
Under the right
center pillar
Instrument
panel brace
RH
IH
J
1 1W
R
B–R
B–R
B
F4 A , F6 B , F9 C
B–G
J21
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–L
(*2)
R–L
(* 2)
A
R–L
(* 1)
A
J24
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–L
(*1)
BATTERY
FL MAIN
3. 0W
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
A
D
D
2 1D
Instrument panel
brace RH
F14
FUEL
SENDER
1
1 IF2
3
2
4 IF2
3 IF2
BR
1 A
100A
ALT
A
II2
R–L
2 F
2
F
F
R–L
1 F
J28
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1 1J
10A
GAUGE
1 1K
J4
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
R–L
R–L
1 C
IG1 4
ACC
Y–R
4 1B
I16
IGNITION SW
2 AM1
B–Y
R
G–W
1 2A
1
1
40A
AM1
E
2
Y–R
2
2 1K
W
2
E
1
G–W
SHORT
PIN
12 2J
R
P ow er S ou rc e
J16
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
7. 5A
DOME
1
2
R–Y
8 1G
D10
DIODE
(Dome)
25 CAMRY
BR
IH
BR
R–L
ED : *1
EC : *2
Rear side of surge tank(* 1)
Intake manifold(*2)
3
1
C o m bina tio n M ete r
R–L
(*2)
R–L
(*1)
1
IG+
3
SI
2
P
SE
4
L
P
Y–G
BR
BR
G–W
Y–R
R–L
R
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
I
H
G
F
E
D
C
B
A
(Cont. next page)
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
V2
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
(Combination Meter)
L
Y–G
W3
WATER TEMP. SENDER
BR
25 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
* 3 : Except * 4
* 4 : TMMK Made, TMC Made USA w/ Traction Control
* 5 : Speedometer
C om b in ation M ete r
5
A
B
7
6
R
R
R–L
R–L
7
D
E
BR
From Engine
Control Module
<2–12><3–9>
BR
2
Y–G
1
P
9
A
A
WATER
TEMP.
A
TACHOMETER
8
C
6
C
L
15
B
7
B
3
A
9
C
SLIP
5
A
TRAC OFF
3
C
DOOR
10
B
O/D OFF
12
A
(*5)
ILLUMINATION
12
C
14
B
TURN LH
1
B
TURN RH
1
C
BRAKE
REAR LIGHTS
4
B
13
A
CHARGE
See Theft Deterrent
System<15–3>
See ABS and
Traction Control
System<18–1>
See Interior Light
System<9–4>
See Electronically Controlled
Transmission and A/T Indicator
System<4–3><5–3>
GR(*3)
B–O(*4)
17
IG3
6
IG1
P–L
11
C
2
C
WASHER LEVEL
HIGH BEAM
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR
LAMP
See Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning Light
System<8–2><8–3>
See Charging System
<1–4>
ABS
4
A
SEAT BELT
W–B
Y–B
5
IJ1
10
C
See Headlight
System<6–3><7–3>
See Cruise Control
System<17–2>
12
B
SRS
C 8 A , C 9 B , C10 C
Y–B
8
B
9
B
CRUISE
4
C
5
B
B
V–W
13
B
1
A
A
W–B
See ABS(TMC Made) System<19–2>
See ABS(TMMK Made) System<20–2>
See ABS and Traction
Control System<18–1>
2
B
OIL
B
J5
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
See Engine Control and
Immobiliser System<2–3><3–2>
B–O
BULB
CHECK
RELAY
B
J15
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
See Illumination System
<10–4>
3
V–W
IG3
W–B
Left radiator
side support
8
A
FUEL
C
P
R–W
See Key Reminder and Seat Belt
Warning System<21–3>
EB
R
B
See Electronically Controlled
Transmission and A/T
Indicator System
<4–4><5–4>
O1
OIL PRESSURE SW
2
W–B
Instrument
panel brace
LH
P3
PARKING BRAKE SW
R–W
IG
1
10
A
16
B
From Park/Neutral
Position SW(A/T) or
Clutch Start SW(M/T)
<1–2>
3
P–L
IK2
W1
WASHER LEVEL
WARNING SW
W–B
A
5
See Charging
System<1–4>
From Daytime Running
Light Relay(Main)
<7–2>
R–W
(*6)
P–L
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
3
IG2
R–W
7 IG1
1
3
BR
See Taillight
System<11–4>
R–W
(* 7)
B2
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
WARNING SW
2
G–W
B–O
B
R–W
1
N
V–W
From Daytime
Running Light
Relay(Main)<7–2>
R–W
(*6)
J2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B
B
7
A
FUEL
V–W
L
7
IJ1
D
6
B
TRIP METER
ODOMETER
I
P
11
A
V–W
H
2
IJ1
2
SECURITY
6
IG3
B–O
C
From Engine Control
Module
<2–7><3–9><4–3><5–3>
Y–G
6
IJ1
6
A
From A/C Control
Assembly<29–5>
G
G–W
3
IJ1
L
From Cruise Control
ECU<17–4>
F
Y–R
Y–R
BR
8
11
B
13
C
See Illumination
System<10–4>
C
* 6 : w/ Daytime Running Light
* 7 : w/o Daytime Running Light
See SRS System
<28–4>
Left kick
panel
IF
COMBINATION METER
J
26 CAMRY
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
B–R
See Taillight
System<11–1>
W–B
(*5)
100A ALT
B–G
Cowl side
panel LH
W–B
F4 A , F7 D , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
IE
W–B(*6)
J38
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R16 A , B
W–B
J39
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
(*5)
1 B
R14 A , R15 B
Right quarter
pillar
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
B
(*3)
W–B
W–B
BO
W–B
EB
W–B
Instrument
panel brace
LH
A
B
(*3)
IG
A
To A/C Control
Assembly<29–5>
B–R
W–B
W–B
(*2)
IJ
W–B
W4
WATER TEMP.
SW NO. 1
L–W
W–B
N2
NOISE FILTER
(Rear Window
Defogger)
W–B
(*8)
To Diode(A/C)
<27–2><29–3>
To Engine Control
Module<2–11>
1
L
(*1)
2 EA1
1
From MG CLT
Relay<27–2>
3 1V
E
2
1
5
3
1
1
Left radiator
side support
1
1
B–R
W–B
W–B
W–R
1
M
2
B–R(*1)
FAN NO. 2 RELAY
1 A
3
IG
4
1 II1
2
G–W
1
2
4
1
1
1
5
3
1
1
1
M
2
2 2H
2
B–R
Right kick
panel
B–R
(*2)
W–B
(*5)
W–R
BATTERY
To Engine Control
Module<2–10>
D
Y–G(*8)
W–B
20 IM1
NOISE FILTER
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
5
5 IK1
L(*1)
L(*1)
1 2G
7 2G
2 2F
R1
RADIATOR FAN MOTOR
7 1G
Y–G
(*7)
20 IE1
L–B
(*5)
L–W
1 EA1
2
A3
A/C SINGLE
PRESSURE SW
W–B
(*6)
1
B
L
(* 1)
W–B
DEFOGGER
RELAY
8 ID1
B
(*4)
12 1J
G–W
(*1)
4 B (*6)
5 A (*5)
A
1 1L
1 2C
G–W
B–W
(*2)
A
R17 A , B
W–B
(*5)
A
MIRROR HEATER RH
[REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR LH]
6 B (*6)
13 2J
4
3
1
2
FAN NO. 1
RELAY
L
MIRROR HEATER RH
[REMOTE CONTROL
MIRROR RH]
To Engine Control
Module<3–6>
B–Y
1 A (*5)
3
2
4
FAN NO. 3 RELAY
L
A
2
2
2 2C 4 2F
3
1
2 2B
2
30A
CDS
1
1 : 1MZ–FE
2 : 5S–FE
3 : w/ Auto Antenna
4 : w/o Auto Antenna
5 : TMC Made
6 : TMMK Made
7 : Automatic A/C
8 : Manual A/C
G–W
FL MAIN
3. 0W
G–O
(*2)
3
1
5
6 2K
30A
RDI
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
R
1 A
TAILLIGHT RELAY
4 B (*6)
5
13 1J
A
6 1A
1
4
R ad ia tor F a n a nd C on d en s er F a n
A1
A/C CONDENSER
FAN MOTOR
2 F
B–Y
(*1)
5 A (*5)
NOISE FILTER
6 B (*6)
40A DEF
1 F
B–Y
1 A (*5)
A
A
3 1R
J32
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
D11
DIODE
(Idle–Up)
5 IM1
7 1J
2
L–B
(*2)
B–Y
1
5 IE1
4 1D
2
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
3
5 1T
B–Y
B–Y
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
11 1J
2
1
L–B
A
A
G–O
9 1C
10A
MIRROR–
HEATER
1
15A ECU–IG
B–R
6 1C
3
10A
TAIL
1
1 1K
10A HEATER
1 1B
40A
AM1
2
5
4 1B
B–Y
3
B–R
1
2
1
2
B–R
B–R
1 D
W
2 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
IG1 4
ACC
B–Y
B–R
B–R
R ea r W ind ow D e fog g er an d
M irror H ea ter
B–R
2 AM1
1
P o w er S ou rc e
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
W5
WATER TEMP.
SW NO. 2
W–B
B–R
R5
REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER SW
W–B
(*8)
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
(*6)
27 CAMRY
A ir C o nd ition in g (M an ua l A /C )
P o w e r S o u rce
1
3
2
4
B–W
1
L–B
4
G
A3
A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
ACC
2 AM1
* 1 : 1MZ–FE
* 2 : 5S–FE
IG1 4
2 IK2
B–Y
1
B
J8
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
2
6
A
5
1
7 GND
A
BR
(*2)
J23
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
OFF
II3
BR
(*2)
2
B
To Engine Control
Module<3–10>
IG
B
BR(*2)
DEF
BR(*2)
F/D
F
F
R–W
(*2)
Instrument
panel brace
LH
W–B
W–R
(*1)
B/L FOOT
W–B
(*1)
F
W–R(*1)
5
1
10
W–R(*1)
B
13
L–A/C
R–W
(*1)
W–B
Left radiator
side support
A
W–L
(*1)
B
SG
J29
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
4
9
B
6 IG
A
LOCK
TH
L–W
(*1)
W–B
BATTERY
G
(*1)
7
IK2
R–B
3
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
10 IK2
14
+B
8
5
L–R
M
A12
A/C AMPLIFIER
S–A/C
1
B5
BLOWER SW
EB
D
FACE
2
A13
A/C EVAPORATOR
J12
TEMP. SENSOR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
R–B
To Engine Control
Module<3–10>
(*2)
3
A
GND
R–B
2
W–L
(* 2)
R–B
(*1)
OFF
ACT
L–R
LO
AC1
To Engine Control
Module<3–10>
4
M1
A
IGN
L–Y
(*2)
8
M2
A
W–B
(*1)
J11
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
B–G
5
HI
A
A
J32
JUNCTION CONNECTOR
L–B
L–B
1
L–O
L–B
B–W
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
FL MAIN
3. 0W
6
B–W
F9 F
2
W–B
1
3
7
W–B(*1)
L–Y
(*1)
1
W–B
B4
BLOWER RESISTOR
M
F4 A , F8 E ,
L–R
1
12
2
J12
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
D
To FAN NO. 3
Relay<26–4>
3
EB1
L–R
L–W
50A HTR
100A ALT
2
2 EB1
B3
BLOWER MOTOR
L–R
B–W
1 E
B–W
(*2)
4
MGC
3
LG–B(*1)
4
L–Y
(*1)
L–W
L–R
1 EB2
B–R
B–R
2 F
1 A
L–W(*1)
DEF
5
L–Y(*2)
B–R
1 F
L
(*1)
1
F/D
B–Y(*1)
1
6
9 IK2
L–O
1
L–R
7
B–L
1
B/L FOOT
8
L–R
1
1
L
1
1 1B
D3
DIODE
(A/C)
1
B–W
1
2
L–W
3
GND FACE
3
From FAN NO. 3
Relay<26–3>
W–B
2
DEF
L–B
R–B
3
5 2K
L–R
40A
AM1
5
F/D
L–B
2
1
2
10A A/C
4
1
B–O(*1)
5
1
MG CLT RELAY
HTR RELAY
L–B
1
1
2
W–R(*1)
BR(*2)
1
1
W–L
FOOT
2 1W 3 1R
From Engine Control
Module<3–10>
To Engine Control
Module<3–10>
B/L
9 2C
From Engine Control
Module<2–7>
FACE
To Engine Control
Module<2–7>
L–B
From Engine Control
Module<2–11>
L–B
H9
HEATER CONTROL SW
10A HEATER
W
L–B
L–B
G
(*2)
L–B
1 1K
I16
IGNITION SW
2 1K
A2
A/C MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AND LOCK SENSOR
4
A
ON
A20
AIR VENT MODE CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
A14
A/C SW
Intake
manifold
EC
J
28 CAMRY
W
B–R
40A AM1
B–R
B–R
W–B
B–G
IG
Y–R
(*2 *3)
S9
SIDE AIRBAG
SQUIB LH
2
P24
PRETENSIONER LH
1
Y–B(*1)
L–B(*2)
A22
AIRBAG SQUIB
(Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly)
2
Y–G
(*2 *3)
A23
AIRBAG SQUIB
(Steering
Wheel Pad)
1
2
S10
SIDE AIRBAG
SQUIB RH
1
E2
2
P25
PRETENSIONER RH
1
3 1V
3 1N
28 B
PR–
6 C
5 C
PR+
LA
3 B
W–B
IE
12 B
SIL
TC
19 B
Cowl side
panel LH
To Data Link Connector 3
<2–3><3–8>
F4 A , F6 C , F9 F
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK
Instrument panel
brace LH
A
2
Y
BATTERY
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
1
W–B
SPIRAL
CABLE
Y–R
(*2 *3)
Y–R
(*2 *3)
FL MAIN
3. 0W
Y–B
2
Y
1
Y–R
(*1 *3)
7 1J
Y–G
(*2 *3)
2 BW1
Y–R
(*2 *3)
Y–G
(*2 *3)
1 BW1
Y–R
(*1 *3)
1 A
SFR–
1 C
SFR+
Y–G
(*1 *3)
2 C
Y–G
(*2 *3)
2 BV1
1 A
ESR
7 C
A
A
Y–B
1 BV1
2 A
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
PL+
PL–
FSR
9 C
VUPR SSR+
12 C 10 C
12 A
10 A
9 A
VUPL SSL+ FSL
ESL
C17 A , C18 B , C19 C
7 A
A
Y
1 1N
+SR
9 B
LG
7 II3
W–B
100A
ALT
1 C
B
2 F
SFL–
6 A
SFL+
Y–G
(*1 *3)
5 A
–SR
20 B
2 IG2
13
W
1 F
P–
11 B
P+
10 B
13 B
D–
Y–R
14 B
D+
Y–G
27 B
E1
B–O
+SL
P–L
(*3)
1 2A
GR
15 B
L–W
(*3)
–SL
LG–B
(*3)
1 1B
BR
26 B
4
GR–L
(*3)
ACC
W–R
6 B
1
P
(*3)
IG2
BR–W
5 B
2
L–Y
(*3)
3
12
To Data Link Connector 1, 2
<18–4><19–3><20–3><20–4>
P–B
1
30A
AM2
4
3
LG
(*3)
2
S8
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR RH
GR
(*3)
1
S7
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR LH
4
J3
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
B–Y
1
10A ECU–B
SHORT
PIN
W–R
4 2L
2
2 IU1
W–R
1 IU1
1
BR–W
B–W
2 IT1
2
B–W
2 1N
BR
1 IT1
1
A
B
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
LG
4 1N
15A
CIG
6 1K
A
B
CONNECTION
DETECTION
PIN
2 1G
3 1W
C9
SRS WARNING LIGHT
[COMB. METER]
2
5A
IGN
3 1K
B–R
A32
AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT RH
W–R
1 : TMC Made
2 : TMMK Made
3 : w/ Side Airbag
4 : TMMK Made 1MZ–FE
P–B
2
IG2 6
ST2
L–R
A31
AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT LH
3
*
*
*
*
LG
2 1K
W–R
I16
IGNITION SW
7 AM2
W–R
IG1
2
W–R
5 1B
5 1K
2 AM1
W
ACC 3
W–R
SRS
B–Y(*4)
LG(Except *4)
7 2J
1
P ow er S ou rc e
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
MEMO
W–R
3 1W
10 1V
W–R
B
F4 A , F6 C , F8 E , F9 F
B–G
Left radiator
side support
W–B
BATTERY
W–B
EB
B–W
6
M
2
L–R
II
W–B
1
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
IG
W–B
2
A
A
Instrument panel
brace LH
SI
W–B
W–B
B–W
L–W
From FAN NO. 3
Relay<26–3>
2
1
1
1
L
3
5
1
D3
DIODE(A/C)
1
3
2
EB
A
Left radiator
side support
W–B
B–W
5 2K
9 2C
A
3 1R
2 1W
L–B
Cowl side
panel RH
J11
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR A
A
W–B
A33
A/C BLOWER MOTOR
LINEAR CONTROLLER
+B
VM
GND
3
4
B–W
FL MAIN
3. 0W
2
1
B3
BLOWER MOTOR
B–W
L–R
L–R
1 A
B–R
50A
HTR
1 E
L–B
100A
ALT
2 F
B–R
B–R
1 F
W–B
1 C
L–R
1 2A
L–W
2
EB1
MG CLT
RELAY
1
L–B
L–W
1 EB2
HTR
RELAY
L–B
B–W
1
3
5
1
2
1
1
1
4
1
L–W
1
L–B
10A
HEATER
1 1K
L–B
SHORT
PIN
1
IG1 4
ACC
3
L–B
1 1B
40A
AM1
I16
IGNITION SW
2 AM1
B–Y
2
A ir C o n ditio ning (A u tom a tic A /C )
L–B
2
2
2 1K
W
1
P o w er S ou rc e
W
7 2J
10A
ECU–B
29 CAMRY
L–Y
A
4
7
IK2
J32
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–B
W–B
L–B
W–B
B–W
B–W
L–Y
L–W
L–B
W–R
J
I
H
G
F
E
D
C
B
A
(Cont. next page)
J OVERALL ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM
B8
BLOWER RESISTOR
(Low Speed)
W–B
29 CAMRY (Cont’ d)
A ir C on ditio n in g (A u to ma tic A /C )
5
A
W–R
7
6
Y–G
8
From Defogger Relay
<26–3>
A34 A , A35 B
13 A
B
IG+
A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
23 A
RDFG
HR
26 A 10 A
MGCR LOCK
2 B
3 A
BLW
16 B
PSW
9 B
SPD
15 A
AIF
6 A
AIR
7 A
TPI
FACE
7 B
4 A
B/L
17 A
FOOT
18 A
F/D
19 A
DEF
20 A
AMH
9 A
AMC
8 A
S5
TS
TP
11 A
5 B
8 B
IGN
16 A
GND
14 A
B–Y
B–O
To Engine Control
Module<2–7>
From Engine Control
Module<2–11>
LG–B
V
F
W–B
From Engine Control
Module<2–7><2–8>
J29
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
W–R
W–R
5
DEF
W–R
4
F/D
Y
3
FOOT
F
W–R F
W–R
2
B/L
6 IG
W–B
W–B
7 GND
M
W–R
L–B
3
5
A39
AIR MIX CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
WARM
L–B
4
W–R
1
W–B
B–Y
2
CONTROL
CIRCUIT
B
B–W
L
A
P
M
COOL
J
1
FACE
G–R
I
L–O
H
B–L
G
AC1
13 B
10 IK2
2
F
L–R
4
L
1
A3
A/C DUAL PRESSURE SW
4
A2
A/C MAGNETIC
CLUTCH AND
LOCK SENSOR
L–W
L–B
B–W
W–L
1
A20
AIR VENT MODE
CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
1
W–R
L
L
F
B–W
ACT
10 B
2
4 IK3
1
W–R
E
TW
14 B
Y
2
W–R
W–R
2 IG1
A38
AIR INLET CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
11 IK2
9 IK2
1
A30
A/C AMBIENT TEMP. SENSOR
1
A13
A/C EVAPORATOR TEMP. SENSOR
W–R
A36
A/C ROOM TEMP. SENSOR
A
B–Y
A
1
2
L–W
L–Y
L–W
G–Y
W–R
B–Y
A
2
L
A
A37
A/C SOLAR SENSOR
L
L
L–B
W–R
D
TAM
3 B
1 IK1
W
3
J1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR
C
TE
6 B
P–L
R
L–Y
5
M
B
W
L
P
G–R
L–O
B–L
L–R
L
L–W
V–W
L–B
To Speedometer
[Comb. Meter]<25–8>
B–W
W–L
L–Y
L–W
L–B
7
TR
4 B
1 IG1
L
6
SG
1 A
W–B
W–R
W–B
J
K POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
K
K POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Fusible Link Block (See Page 19)
Fuse
50A
100A
HTR
ALT
System
Page
Air Conditioning (Automatic A/C)
Air Conditioning (Manual A/C)
292
300
Charging
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
Illumination
Light Auto Turn Off
62
100
126
110
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
Taillight
Theft Deterrent (TMC Made)
Theft Deterrent (TMMK Made)
288
132
182
188
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
162
172
Instrument Panel J/B (See Page 20)
Fuse
System
Page
Charging
Combination Meter
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1MZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (5S–FE)
62
280
202
210
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
Engine Control (5S–FE)
SRS
66
82
245
Combination Meter
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1MZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (5S–FE)
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
280
202
210
66
Engine Control (5S–FE)
Starting and Ignition (1MZ–FE)
Starting and Ignition (5S–FE)
82
54
58
OBD
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
Engine Control (5S–FE)
66
82
7.5A
PANEL
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
Combination Meter
Illumination
258
280
126
7.5A
RAD–NO.2
Auto Antenna
Radio and Player (Built–In Type Amplifier)
Radio and Player (Separate Type Amplifier)
272
278
274
7.5A
TURN
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light
114
ABS (TMC Made)
ABS (TMMK Made)
ABS and Traction Control
Back–Up Light
234
240
226
138
Charging
62
5A
5A
7.5A
10A
IGN
STARTER
GAUGE
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
K
Fuse
10A
10A
10A
10A
15A
15A
15A
System
Page
Combination Meter
Cruise Control
Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
280
218
150
156
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1MZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (5S–FE)
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
Engine Control (5S–FE)
202
210
66
82
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning
Light Auto Turn Off
Moon Roof
100
260
110
194
Power Window
Stop Light
Taillight
144
118
132
HEATER
Air Conditioning (Automatic A/C)
Air Conditioning (Manual A/C)
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
292
300
268
MIRROR–HEATER
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
Engine Control (5S–FE)
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
66
82
268
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
Engine Control (5S–FE)
Taillight
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
66
82
132
162
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
172
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
Remote Control Mirror
Shift Lock
SRS
258
266
252
245
ABS (TMC Made)
ABS (TMMK Made)
ABS and Traction Control
Auto Antenna
234
240
226
272
Cruise Control
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
Shift Lock
Theft Deterrent (TMC Made)
218
288
252
182
Theft Deterrent (TMMK Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
188
162
172
Power Outlet
264
GAUGE
TAIL
CIG
ECU–IG
POWER–OUTLET
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
K POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Fuse
15A
25A
25A
30A
STOP
WIPER
DOOR
POWER
System
Page
ABS (TMC Made)
ABS (TMMK Made)
ABS and Traction Control
Cruise Control
234
240
226
218
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1MZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (5S–FE)
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
Engine Control (5S–FE)
202
210
66
82
Shift Lock
Stop Light
252
118
Wiper and Washer
140
Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
Moon Roof
Power Window
150
156
194
144
Theft Deterrent (TMC Made)
Theft Deterrent (TMMK Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
182
188
162
172
Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
Moon Roof
Power Seat
150
156
194
198
Power Window
144
40A
AM1
Charging
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
62
288
40A
DEF
Rear Window Defogger and Mirror Heater
268
Engine Room J/B No.2 (See Page 22)
Fuse
5A
7.5A
ALT–S
DOME
System
Page
Charging
62
Cigarette Lighter and Clock
Combination Meter
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
Interior Light
258
280
100
122
Key Reminder and Seat Belt Warning
Light Auto Turn Off
Moon Roof
Theft Deterrent (TMC Made)
260
110
194
182
Theft Deterrent (TMMK Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
188
162
172
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
K
Fuse
System
Page
10A
ECU–B
Air Conditioning (Automatic A/C)
Combination Meter
SRS
10A
HAZARD
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Light
114
Horn
Theft Deterrent (TMC Made)
Theft Deterrent (TMMK Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
256
182
188
162
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
172
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (1MZ–FE)
Electronically Controlled Transmission and A/T Indicator (5S–FE)
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
Engine Control (5S–FE)
202
210
66
82
Engine Immobiliser System
94
10A
15A
HORN
EFI
292
280
245
15A
HEAD (LH)
Headlight (w/o Daytime Running Light)
96
15A
HEAD (RH)
Headlight (w/o Daytime Running Light)
96
15A
HEAD LH (UPR)
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
100
15A
HEAD RH (UPR)
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
100
RADIO NO.1
Auto Antenna
Radio and Player (Built–In Type Amplifier)
Radio and Player (Separate Type Amplifier)
272
278
274
Charging
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
Engine Control (5S–FE)
Starting and Ignition (1MZ–FE)
62
66
82
54
Starting and Ignition (5S–FE)
58
20A
30A
AM2
30A
CDS
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
288
30A
RDI
Radiator Fan and Condenser Fan
288
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
Headlight (w/o Daytime Running Light)
Light Auto Turn Off
Starting and Ignition (1MZ–FE)
100
96
110
54
Starting and Ignition (5S–FE)
Theft Deterrent (TMC Made)
Theft Deterrent (TMMK Made)
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMC Made)
58
182
188
162
Wireless Door Lock Control (TMMK Made)
172
40A
MAIN
Engine Room R/B No.1 (See Page 24)
Fuse
System
Page
10A
A/C
Air Conditioning (Manual A/C)
300
25A
A/F HTR
Engine Control (1MZ–FE)
66
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
K POWER SOURCE (Current Flow Chart)
Engine Room R/B No.2 (See Page 24)
Fuse
System
Page
5A
DRL NO.2
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
100
10A
H–LP LH (LWR)
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
100
10A
H–LP RH (LWR)
Headlight (w/ Daytime Running Light)
100
Engine Room R/B No.3 (TMMK Made w/ ABS and Traction Control)
(TMC Made w/ ABS, w/ ABS and Traction Control) or
Fusible Link Block (TMMK Made w/ ABS w/o Traction Control) (See Page 25)
Fuse
60A
FL ABS
System
ABS (TMC Made)
ABS (TMMK Made)
ABS and Traction Control
∗ These are the page numbers of the first page on which the related system is shown.
Page
234
240
226
MEMO
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Code
Part Name
Part Number
Code
Part Name
Part Number
A1
A/C Condenser Fan Motor
90980–10928
B4
Blower Resistor
90980–10976
A2
A/C Magnetic Clutch and Lock Sensor
90980–10942
B5
Blower SW
90980–10877
A3
A/C Triple Pressure SW
(A/C Dual and Single Pressure SW)
90980–10943
B6
Buckle SW LH
B7
Buckle SW LH
B8
Blower Resistor (Low Speed)
C1
Camshaft Position Sensor
C2
Crankshaft Position Sensor
C3
Cruise Control Actuator
90980–11150
C4
Cigarette Lighter
90980–10760
C5
Cigarette Lighter Illumination
90980–11148
C6
Clock
90980–11013
C7
Clutch Start SW
90980–10825
A4
ABS Actuator
90980–11413
A5
ABS Actuator
90980–10891
A6
ABS Actuator and ECU
90080–98070
A7
ABS and Traction Actuator
90980–11698
A8
ABS and Traction Actuator
90980–11413
A9
ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
A10
ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
A11
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
90980–11178
A12
A/C Amplifier
90980–10807
A13
A/C Evaporator Temp. Sensor
90980–10825
A14
A/C SW
90980–10631
A15
ABS and Traction ECU
90980–11390
A16
ABS and Traction ECU
90980–11391
A17
ABS and Traction ECU
A18
ABS ECU
A19
ABS ECU
90980–11390
A20
Air Vent Mode Control Servo Motor
90980–11165
A22
Airbag Squib
(Front Passenger Airbag Assembly)
90980–11884
A23
Airbag Squib (Steering Wheel Pad)
90980–10850
A24
Ashtray Illumination
81945–33010
A25
A26
ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
Auto Antenna Motor and Relay
A28
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
A30
A/C Ambient Temp. Sensor
A31
Airbag Sensor Front LH
90980–11060
90980–11697
90980–11178
90980–11070
90980–11856
Airbag Sensor Front RH
A33
A/C Blower Motor Linear Controller
90980–11676
A34
A/C Control Assembly
90980–11390
A35
A/C Control Assembly
90980–11391
A36
A/C Room Temp. Sensor
90980–10825
A37
A/C Solar Sensor
90980–11918
A38
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
90980–11165
A39
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
90980–11319
A40
Automatic Light Control Sensor
90980–11107
B1
Back–Up Light SW
90980–11250
B2
Brake Fluid Level Warning SW
90980–11207
Blower Motor
C9
90980–10903
90980–10976
90980–10947
Combination Meter (TMC Made)
90980–11114
Combination Meter (TMMK Made)
90980–98048
Combination Meter (TMC Made)
90980–11113
Combination Meter (TMMK Made)
90980–98046
Combination Meter (TMC Made)
90980–11115
Combination Meter (TMMK Made)
90980–98047
C11
Combination SW
90980–11594
C12
Combination SW
90980–11616
C13
Combination SW
90980–11672
C14
Cruise Control Clutch SW
90980–10906
C15
Cruise Control ECU
90980–11391
C16
Condenser
90980–10860
C17
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11869
C18
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11872
C19
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
90980–11867
Data Link Connector 1 (1MZ–FE)
90980–11195
90980–11424
A32
B3
C8
C10
ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
A27
A29
90980–11075
90980–10825
D1
Data Link Connector 1 (5S–FE)
90980–11323
D2
Daytime Running Light Resistor
90980–10928
D3
Diode (A/C)
90980–11071
D4
Data Link Connector 2
90980–11417
D5
Data Link Connector 3
90980–11665
D6
Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
90980–11058
D7
Di d (Courtesy)
Diode
(C t
)
D10
Diode (Dome)
D11
Diode (Idle–Up)
D12
Door Courtesy SW Front LH
D13
Door Courtesy SW Front RH
D14
Door Courtesy SW Rear LH
D15
Door Courtesy SW Rear RH
D16
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front LH
D17
Door Key Lock and Unlock SW Front RH
90980–10962
90980–11071
90980–10871
90980–11490
Note: Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply. In case of ordering
a connector or terminal with wire, please confirm in advance if there is supply for it using “Parts Catalog
News” (published by Parts Engineering Administration Dept.).
L
Code
D18
D19
D20
Part Name
Part Number
Code
Door Lock Control SW RH (TMC Made)
90980–11326
H1
Headlight LH
Door Lock Control SW RH (TMMK Made)
90980–10797
H2
Headlight RH
H3
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
H4
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 2 Sensor 1)
H5
Horn (High)
H6
Horn (Low)
H7
Hazard SW
H8
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
90980–11028
H9
Heater Control SW
90980–10799
H10
High Mounted Stop Light
90980–11148
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Front LH
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Front RH
D21
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Rear LH
D22
Door Lock Motor and Door Unlock
Detection SW Rear RH
90980–11150
E1
EGR Gas Temp. Sensor
90980–10899
E2
EGR Valve Position Sensor
90980–11143
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Solenoid (1MZ–FE)
90980–10854
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Solenoid (5S–FE)
90980–11156
E4
Electronically Controlled Transmission
Solenoid
90980–11143
E5
Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor
90980–10737
E6
Engine Hood Courtesy SW
90980–11189
Engine Control Module (1MZ–FE)
90980–11638
Engine Control Module (5S–FE)
90980–11392
Engine Control Module (1MZ–FE)
90980–11637
Engine Control Module (5S–FE)
90980–11391
Engine Control Module (1MZ–FE)
90980–11586
Engine Control Module (5S–FE)
90980–11390
Engine Control Module (1MZ–FE)
90980–11476
Engine Control Module (5S–FE)
90980–11408
E11
Engine Control Module
90980–11421
F1
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light
LH
E3
E7
E8
E9
E10
90980–11020
Part Name
Part Number
90980–11314
90980–11028
90980–10619
90980–10801
I1
Idle Air Control Valve
90980–11145
I2
Igniter
90980–11653
I3
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.1
I4
Ignition Coil and Igniter No.2
I5
Ignition Coil No.1
I6
Ignition Coil No.2
I7
Ignition Coil No.3
I8
Injector No.1
I9
Injector No.2
I10
Injector No.3
I11
Injector No.4
I12
Injector No.5
I13
Injector No.6
I14
Intake Air Temp. Sensor
90980–11163
I15
Ignition Key Cylinder Light
90980–10906
I16
Ignition SW
90980–11615
I17
Integration Relay
90980–11107
Integration Relay (w/ Theft Deterrent)
90980–11058
Integration Relay (w/o Theft Deterrent)
90980–11542
I19
Interior Light
90980–10121
I18
90980–11150
90980–11246
90980–11153
F2
Front Turn Signal Light and Parking Light
RH
F3
Front Wiper Motor
J1
Junction Connector
90980–11542
F4
Fusible Link Block
J2
Junction Connector
90980–10803
F5
Fusible Link Block
J3
Junction Connector
90980–11542
F6
Fusible Link Block
J4
Junction Connector
90980–10803
F7
Fusible Link Block
J5
Junction Connector
90980–11542
F8
Fusible Link Block
J6
Junction Connector
90980–11502
F9
Fusible Link Block
J7
Junction Connector
F10
Front Door Speaker LH
J8
Junction Connector
F11
Front Door Speaker RH
J9
Junction Connector
F12
Front Tweeter (Speaker) LH
J10
Junction Connector
90980–11599
–
90980–11579
90980–10825
90980–10916
90980–11661
F13
Front Tweeter (Speaker) RH
J11
Junction Connector
90980–10976
F14
Fuel Pump and Sender
90980–11077
J12
Junction Connector
90980–10803
G1
Generator
90980–09213
J13
Junction Connector
G2
Generator
90980–11349
J14
Junction Connector
G3
Glove Box Light and SW
90980–11098
90980–11661
L PART NUMBER OF CONNECTORS
Code
Part Name
J15
Junction Connector
J16
Junction Connector
J17
Junction Connector
J18
Junction Connector
J19
Junction Connector
Part Number
Code
Part Name
Part Number
P1
Park/Neutral Position SW,A/T Indicator Light
SW and Back–Up Light SW
90980–11332
P2
Power Steering Oil Pressure SW
90980–11428
P3
Parking Brake SW
90980–10871
P4
Power Outlet
90980–10760
P5
Personal Light
90980–10825
P6
Power Window Control SW Front RH
90980–10789
P7
Power Window Control SW Rear LH
P8
Power Window Control SW Rear RH
P9
Power Window Master SW and Door Lock
Control SW LH
P10
Power Window Motor Front LH
P11
Power Window Motor Front RH
P12
Power Window Motor Rear LH
P13
Power Window Motor Rear RH
P14
Power Seat Control SW (Driver’s Seat)
P15
Power Seat Control SW
(Front Passenger’s Seat)
P16
Power Seat Motor
(Driver’s Seat Rear Vertical Control)
P17
Power Seat Motor
(Driver’s Seat Reclining Control)
P18
Power Seat Motor
(Driver’s Seat Slide Control)
P19
Power Seat Motors (Driver’s Seat)
90980–10803
P20
Power Seat Motor (Front Passenger’s Seat
Rear Vertical Control)
90980–10976
P21
Power Seat Motor (Front Passenger’s Seat
Reclining Control)
90980–11166
P22
Power Seat Motor (Front Passenger’s Seat
Slide Control)
P23
Power Seat Motors
(Front Passenger’s Seat)
P24
Pretensioner LH
P25
Pretensioner RH
R1
Radiator Fan Motor
90980–10928
R2
Radio and Player
90980–10996
R3
Radio and Player
90980–10997
R4
Radio and Player
90980–11264
R5
Rear Window Defogger SW
90980–11280
R6
Remote Control Mirror SW
90980–11450
R7
Rheostat
90980–10908
R8
Rear Combination Light LH
90980–10795
90980–10803
90980–11661
90980–11542
J20
Junction Connector
90980–11539
J21
Junction Connector
90980–11542
J22
Junction Connector
J23
Junction Connector
J24
Junction Connector
J25
Junction Connector
J26
Junction Connector
J27
Junction Connector
J28
Junction Connector
J29
Junction Connector
J30
Junction Connector
J31
Junction Connector
J32
Junction Connector
J33
Junction Connector
J34
Junction Connector
90980–11539
90980–11529
90980–11661
90980–11502
90980–11661
90980–10803
90980–11661
J35
Junction Connector
J36
Junction Connector
J37
Junction Connector
J38
Junction Connector
J39
Junction Connector
J40
Junction Connector
K1
Knock Sensor 1
K2
Knock Sensor 2
K3
Key Interlock Solenoid
L1
License Plate Light LH
L2
License Plate Light RH
L3
Light Failure Sensor
90980–10803
L4
Luggage Compartment Key Unlock SW
90980–11212
90980–11542
90980–10825
90980–11148
L5
Luggage Compartment Light
90980–11148
L6
Luggage Compartment Light SW
90980–11097
M1
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
90980–10845
M2
Mass Air Flow Meter
90980–11317
M3
Moon Roof Control SW and Relay
90980–10799
M4
Moon Roof Motor and Limit SW
90980–11011
N1
Noise Filter (Ignition)
90980–10843
N2
Noise Filter (Rear Window Defogger)
90980–11259
O1
Oil Pressure SW
90980–11363
O2
O/D Main SW and A/T Shift Lever
Illumination
90980–10795
90980–10631
90980–10807
90980–10860
90980–10803
90980–10825
90980–11001
90980–10825
90980–11001
90980–11862
R9
Rear Combination Light LH
90980–11001
R10
Rear Combination Light RH
90980–10795
R11
Rear Combination Light RH
90980–11001
Note: Not all of the above part numbers of the connector are established for the supply. In case of ordering
a connector or terminal with wire, please confirm in advance if there is supply for it using “Parts Catalog
News” (published by Parts Engineering Administration Dept.).
L
Code
Part Name
R12
Rear Speaker LH
R13
Rear Speaker RH
R14
Rear Window Defogger
R15
Rear Window Defogger
R16
R17
Part Number
90980–10860
90980–10792
Remote Control Mirror LH
(TMC Made w/ Mirror Heater)
90980–10558
Remote Control Mirror LH
(TMC Made w/o Mirror Heater)
90980–10395
Remote Control Mirror LH
(TMMK Made w/ Mirror Heater)
90980–11487
Remote Control Mirror LH
(TMMK Made w/o Mirror Heater)
90980–11489
Remote Control Mirror RH
(TMC Made w/ Mirror Heater)
90980–10558
Remote Control Mirror RH
(TMC Made w/o Mirror Heater)
90980–10395
Remote Control Mirror RH
(TMMK Made w/ Mirror Heater)
90980–11487
Remote Control Mirror RH (TMMK Made
w/o Mirror Heater)
90980–11489
S1
Starter
90980–09689
S2
Starter
90980–11400
S3
Shift Lock ECU
90980–11488
S4
Stereo Component Amplifier
90980–10848
S5
Stereo Component Amplifier
90980–10807
S6
Stop Light SW
90980–11118
S7
Side Airbag Sensor LH
S8
Side Airbag Sensor RH
S9
Side Airbag Squib LH
S10
Side Airbag Squib RH
90980–11857
90980–11864
Code
Part Name
Part Number
T1
Theft Deterrent Horn
90980–11235
T2
Throttle Position Sensor
90980–11261
T3
Theft Deterrent ECU
90980–11424
T4
Theft Deterrent ECU
90980–11392
T5
Traction Off SW
90980–11013
T6
Turn Signal Flasher
82751–50010
T7
Transponder Key Amplifier
90980–10789
U1
Unlock Warning SW
90980–10860
V1
Vapor Pressure Sensor
90980–11860
V2
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Combination Meter)
90980–11143
V3
Vehicle Speed Sensor (Electronically
Controlled Transmission)
90980–11156
VSV (EGR)(1MZ–FE)
90980–11149
V4
VSV (EGR)(5S–FE)
90980–11156
V5
VSV (EVAP)
V6
VSV (Intake Air Control)
90980–11149
V7
VSV (Vapor Pressure Sensor)
90980–11859
V8
Vanity Light LH
V9
Vanity Light RH
W1
Washer Level Warning SW
90980–11068
W2
Washer Motor
90980–10981
W3
Water Temp. Sender
90980–11428
W4
Water Temp. SW No.1
90980–11235
W5
Water Temp. SW No.2
90980–11243
W6
Wireless Door Lock ECU
90980–11264
90980–10621
EM–1
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CO/HC
CO/HC
EM07X–05
INSPECTION
HINT:
This check is used only to determine whether or not the idle CO/
HC complies with regulations.
1.
INITIAL CONDITIONS
(a) Engine at normal operating temperature
(b) Air cleaner installed
(c) All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected
(d) All accessories switched OFF
(e) All vacuum lines properly connected
HINT:
All vacuum hoses for EGR system, etc. should be properly connected.
(f)
SFI system wiring connectors fully plugged
(g) Ignition timing checked correctly
(h) Transmission in neutral position
(i)
Tachometer and CO/HC meter calibrated by hand
CO/HC Meter
S04994
2.
3.
START ENGINE
RACE ENGINE AT 2,500 RPM FOR APPROX. 180 SECONDS
4.
INSERT CO/HC METER TESTING PROBE AT LEAST
40 cm (1.3 ft) INTO TAILPIPE DURING IDLING
5.
IMMEDIATELY CHECK CO/HC CONCENTRATION AT
IDLE AND/OR 2,500 RPM
Complete the measuring within 3 minutes.
HINT:
When performing the 2 mode (2,500 rpm and idle) test, follow
the measurement order prescribed by the applicable local regulations.
Author:
Date:
1173
EM–2
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CO/HC
If the CO/HC concentration does not comply with regulations,
troubleshoot in the order given below.
(1) Check oxygen sensor operation.
(See page DI–66)
(2) See the table below for possible causes, then inspect and correct the applicable causes if necessary.
CO
HC
Symptom
Causes
Normal
High
Rough idle
1. Faulty ignitions:
Incorrect timing
Fouled, shorted or improperly gapped plugs
O
Open
en or crossed high–tension cords
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3. Leaky EGR valve
4. Leaky intake and exhaust valves
5. Leaky cylinder
Low
High
Rough idle
(Fluctuating HC reading)
1. Vacuum leaks:
PCV hose
EGR valve
Intake manifold
Throttle body
IAC valve
Brake booster line
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
High
High
Rough idle
(Black smoke from exhaust)
1. Restricted air filter
2. Faulty SFI system
Faulty pressure regulator
Defective ECT sensor
Defective IAT sensor
Faulty ECM
Faulty injector
Faulty throttle position sensor
MAP sensor
Author:
Date:
1174
EM–3
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
COMPRESSION
COMPRESSION
EM07Y–05
INSPECTION
HINT:
If there is lack of power, excessive oil consumption or poor fuel
economy, measure the compression pressure.
1.
WARM UP AND STOP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2.
DISCONNECT IGNITION COIL CONNECTORS
3.
REMOVE SPARK PLUGS (See page IG–1)
Compression
Gauge
S05312
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSPECT CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE
Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug hole.
Fully open the throttle.
While cranking the engine, measure the compression
pressure.
HINT:
Always use a fully charged battery to obtain engine speed of
250 rpm or more.
(d) Repeat steps (a) through (c) for each cylinder.
NOTICE:
This measurement must be done in as short a time as possible.
Compression pressure:
1,226 kPa (12.5 kgf/cm2, 178 psi) or more
Minimum pressure: 981 kPa (10.0 kgf/cm2, 142 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi) or less
(e) If the cylinder compression in one or more cylinders is low,
pour a small amount of engine oil into the cylinder through
the spark plug hole and repeat steps (a) through (c) for
cylinders with low compression.
If adding oil helps the compression, it is likely that
the piston rings and/or cylinder bore are worn or
damaged.
If pressure stays low, a valve may be sticking or
seating is improper, or there may be leakage past
the gasket.
5.
REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS (See page IG–1)
6.
RECONNECT IGNITION COIL CONNECTORS
Author:
Date:
1175
EM–4
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
VALVE CLEARANCE
VALVE CLEARANCE
EM07Z–03
INSPECTION
HINT:
Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when the engine is cold.
1.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the clamps on
the cylinder head cover.
(b) Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the spark
plugs.
(c)
(d)
(e)
(c)
(f)
Disconnect the PCV hose from the intake manifold.
Disconnect the PCV hose from the cylinder head cover.
Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the mounting bolt
of the No.2 timing belt cover.
Remove the cylinder head cover. (See page EM–33)
(e)
(d)
S05289
2.
(a)
SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with timing
mark ”0” of the No.1 timing belt cover.
(b) Check that the valve lifters on the No.1 cylinder are loose
and valve lifters on the No.4 are tight.
If not, turn the crankshaft one revolution (360°) and align the
mark as above.
Turn
S05590
1 1
1 1
3.
(a)
2 2
3
3
P03443
(b)
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
Check only the valves indicated.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
(2) Record the out–of–specification valve clearance
measurements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement adjusting shim.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.19 – 0.29 mm (0.007 – 0.011 in.)
Exhaust
0.28 – 0.38 mm (0.011 – 0.015 in.)
Turn the crankshaft one revolution (360°) and align the
mark as above.
Author:
Date:
1176
EM–5
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
3
2 2
3
4
4
4
4
–
VALVE CLEARANCE
(c)
Check only the valves indicated as shown. Measure the
valve clearance. (See step (a))
4.
(a)
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
Remove the adjusting shim.
(1) Turn the crankshaft so that the cam lobe of the camshaft on the adjusting valve points upward.
(2) Position the notch of the valve lifter facing the spark
plug side.
P03442
Upward
Cam Lobe
Notch
Spark Plug Side
P13927
(3)
Using SST (A), press down the valve lifter and place
SST (B) between the camshaft and valve lifter. Remove SST (A).
SST 09248–55040 (09248–05410, 09248–05420)
SST (A)
SST (B)
HINT:
Apply SST (B) at slight angle on the side marked with ”9”, at the
position shown in the illustration.
Spark Plug Side
P13988
(4)
Remove the adjusting shim with a small screwdriver
and magnetic finger.
Magnetic
Finger
P13926
(b)
EM0494
Determine the replacement adjusting shim size by following the Formula or Charts:
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the
removed shim.
(2) Calculate the thickness of a new shim so that the
valve clearance comes within specified value.
T ........... Thickness of removed shim
A ........... Measured valve clearance
N ........... Thickness of new shim
Intake: N = T + (A – 0.24 mm (0.009 in.))
Author:
Date:
1177
EM–6
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
VALVE CLEARANCE
Exhaust: N = T + (A – 0.33 mm (0.013 in.))
(3) Select a new shim with a thickness as close as possible to the calculated value.
HINT:
Shims are available in 17 sizes in increments of 0.05 mm
(0.0020 in.), from 2.50 mm (0.0984 in.) to 3.30 mm (0.1299 in.).
(c)
SST (A)
SST (B)
(d)
Install a new adjusting shim.
(1) Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter.
(2) Using SST (A), press down the valve lifter and remove SST (B).
SST 09248–55040 (09248–05410, 09248–05420)
Recheck the valve clearance.
P13989
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(b)
(d)
(e)
(c)
S05289
(f)
REINSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER
Install the cylinder head cover. (See page EM–53)
Connect the PCV hose to the intake manifold.
Connect the PCV hose to the cylinder head cover.
Install the engine wire clamp to the mounting bolt of the
No.2 timing belt cover.
Install the 4 high–tension cords to the clamps on the cylinder head cover.
Connect the 4 high–tension cords to the spark plugs.
Author:
Date:
1178
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Intake)
Installed shim thickness
mm (in.)
Measured clearance
mm (in.)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
Date:
Intake valve clearance (Cold):
0.19 – 0.29 mm (0.007 – 0.011 in.)
Shim
No.
Thickness
Shim
No.
Thickness
1
2.500 (0.0984)
10
2.950 (0.1161)
2
2.550 (0.1004)
11
3.000 (0.1181)
3
2.600 (0.1024)
12
3.050 (0.1201)
4
2.650 (0.1043)
13
3.100 (0.1220)
5
2.700 (0.1063)
14
3.150 (0.1240)
6
2.750 (0.1083)
15
3.200 (0.1260)
7
2.800 (0.1102)
16
3.250 (0.1280)
8
2.850 (0.1122)
17
3.300 (0.1299)
9
2.900 (0.1142)
HINT: New shims have the thickness in millimeters
imprinted on the face.
EM–7
V00867
1179
EXAMPLE: The 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim is installed,
and the measured clearance is 0.450 mm (0.0177 in.).
Replace the 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim with a new No.11
shim.
mm (in.)
VALVE CLEARANCE
Author:
New shim thickness
EM–8
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Exhaust)
Installed shim thickness
mm (in.)
Measured clearance
mm (in.)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
mm (in.)
Shim
No.
Thickness
Shim
No.
Thickness
1
2.500 (0.0984)
10
2.950 (0.1161)
2
2.550 (0.1004)
11
3.000 (0.1181)
3
2.600 (0.1024)
12
3.050 (0.1201)
4
2.650 (0.1043)
13
3.100 (0.1220)
Date:
1180
V00868
5
2.700 (0.1063)
14
3.150 (0.1240)
Exhaust valve clearance (Cold):
0.28 – 0.38 mm (0.011 – 0.015 in.)
6
2.750 (0.1083)
15
3.200 (0.1260)
7
2.800 (0.1102)
16
3.250 (0.1280)
EXAMPLE: The 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim is installed,
and the measured clearance is 0.450 mm (0.0177 in.).
Replace the 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim with a new No.9
shim.
8
2.850 (0.1122)
17
3.300 (0.1299)
9
2.900 (0.1142)
HINT: New shims have the thickness in millimeters
imprinted on the face.
VALVE CLEARANCE
Author:
New shim thickness
EM–9
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
IGNITION TIMING
IGNITION TIMING
EM080–03
INSPECTION
1.
WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
3.
CONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR OBDII
SCAN TOOL
Remove the fuse cover on the instrument panel.
Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII scan tool
to the DLC3.
Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII
scan tool operator’s manual for further details.
CONNECT TIMING LIGHT TO ENGINE
S05331
TE1
4.
(a)
E1
INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
HINT:
After engine rpm is kept at 1,000 – 1,300 rpm for 5 seconds,
check that it returns to idle speed.
SST
A07370
(b)
(c)
5.
S05309
Using a timing light, check the ignition timing.
Ignition timing: 8 – 12° BTDC @ idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
FURTHER CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing: 0 – 10° BTDC @ idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
HINT:
The timing mark moves in a range between 0° and 10°.
6.
DISCONNECT TIMING LIGHT FROM ENGINE
7.
DISCONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR
OBDII SCAN TOOL
Author:
Date:
1181
EM–10
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
IDLE SPEED
IDLE SPEED
EM081–05
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
INITIAL CONDITIONS
Engine at normal operating temperature
Air cleaner installed
All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected
All vacuum lines properly connected
SFI system wiring connectors fully plugged
All operating accessories switched OFF
Ignition timing check correctly
Transmission in neutral position
Air conditioning switched OFF
2.
S05331
CONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR OBDII
SCAN TOOL
(a) Remove the fuse cover on the instrument panel.
(b) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII scan tool
to the DLC3.
(c) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII
scan tool operator’s manual for further details.
3.
INSPECT IDLE SPEED
(a) Race the engine at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed (w/ Cooling fan OFF): 700 ± 50 rpm
If the idle speed is not as specified, check the IAC valve and air
intake system.
4.
DISCONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR
OBDII SCAN TOOL
Author:
Date:
1182
EM–11
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
BALANCE SHAFT BACKLASH
BALANCE SHAFT BACKLASH
EM082–04
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
Crankshaft
Gear
TDC
30°
1
100°
2
A
3
210°
B
4
No.1 Balance
Shaft Gear
280°
B
A
C
Z19417
REMOVE OIL PAN AND OIL STRAINER
(See page LU–7)
2.
INSPECT BACKLASH OF CRANKSHAFT GEAR AND
NO.1 BALANCE SHAFT GEAR
NOTICE:
Backlash between the crankshaft gear and No.1 balance
shaft gear varies with the rotation of the balance shaft and
the deviation of the crankshaft gear. Accordingly, it is necessary to measure the backlash at the 4 points shown in
the illustration on the left.
(a) Turn the crankshaft 2 or 3 times to settle the crankshaft
gear and No.1 balance shaft gear.
(b) When No.1 piston is at TDC, check that the punch marks
C shown in the illustration of the balance shafts are
aligned with the grooves of the No.2 housing.
C
P06121
(c)
Check that punch marks A and B are at the positions on
the No.1 balance shaft indicated in the illustration.
(d)
First turn the crankshaft clockwise, and align the groove
of the No.2 balance shaft housing with punch mark A of
the No.1 balance shaft.
Mark B
Mark A
No.1 Balance Shaft
No.2 Housing
Z19411
Mark B
No.1 Balance
Shaft
No.2 Housing
Mark A
Z19413
Author:
Date:
1183
EM–12
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(e)
–
BALANCE SHAFT BACKLASH
Set SST and a dial indicator as shown in the illustration.
SST 09224–74010
HINT:
Make sure that the stem of the dial indicator is perpendicular to
the SST and that it is placed in the middle of the 3rd indentation.
SST
Measuring Point
for Dial Indicator
P25734
(f)
Lightly turn the No.1 balance shaft by hand until resistance is felt, and measure the backlash.
HINT:
SST
P06039
Turn the No.1 balance shaft 4 or 5 times to provide a
steady backlash reading.
To prevent excessive backlash due to thrust clearance,
measure the backlash while pressing on the rear of the
No.1 balance shaft.
Standard backlash (at punch mark A):
0.025 – 0.065 mm (0.0010 – 0.0026 in.)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the No.1 balance shaft strongly.
(g) Remove the dial indicator and SST.
(h)
Mark A
(i)
(j)
No.2 Housing
No.1 Balance
Shaft
(k)
Turn the crankshaft clockwise to align the groove of the
No.2 housing with punch mark B.
Set the dial indicator. (See step (e))
Measure the backlash. (See step (f))
Standard backlash (at punch mark B):
0.025 – 0.085 mm (0.0010 – 0.0033 in.)
Remove the dial indicator.
Mark B
Z19415
(l)
Mark B
(m)
(n)
No.2 Housing
No.1 Balance
Shaft
(o)
Mark A
Turn the crankshaft clockwise again to align the groove
of the No.2 housing with punch mark A.
Set the dial indicator. (See step (e))
Measure the backlash. (See step (f))
Standard backlash (at punch mark A):
0.025 – 0.065 mm (0.0010 – 0.0026 in.)
Remove the dial indicator.
Z19413
Author:
Date:
1184
EM–13
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
BALANCE SHAFT BACKLASH
(p)
Mark A
No.2 Housing
No.1 Balance
Shaft
Mark B
Z19415
Turn the crankshaft clockwise again to align the groove
of the No.2 housing with punch mark B.
(q) Set the dial indicator. (See step (e))
(r)
Measure the backlash. (See step (f))
Standard backlash (at punch mark B):
0.025 – 0.085 mm (0.0010 – 0.0033 in.)
(s) Remove the dial indicator.
If even one of the 4 points measured above exceeds the backlash specification, adjust the backlash with new spacers.
NOTICE:
Use the same size spacers for both the left and right sides.
HINT:
Varying the spacer thickness by 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
changes the backlash by about 0.014 mm (0.0006 in.).
If the backlash is greater than the permitted maximum,
select a thinner shim.
If the backlash is less than the specification, select a thicker shim.
3.
(a)
(b)
3
5
REPLACE NEW SPACERS
Uniformly loosen the 6 bolts in the sequence shown.
Replace the spacers with new ones.
1
2
6
4
Z19408
4
Pull
6
2
5
1
3
Z19409
4.
TIGHTEN BALANCE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
While pulling the center part of the engine balancer in the direction of the arrow, uniformly tighten the 6 bolts in several passes,
in the sequence shown.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
5.
INSPECT AND ADJUST BACKLASH OF CRANKSHAFT GEAR AND NO.1 BALANCE SHAFT GEAR
(See step 2)
6.
REINSTALL OIL STRAINER AND OIL PAN
(See page LU–13)
Author:
Date:
1185
EM–14
Adjusting Spacer Selection Chart (On–Vehicle)
Measured
backlash
Installed spacer
No.
mm (in.)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
BALANCE SHAFT BACKLASH
Author:
Date:
Standard backlash (at punch mark A):
0.025 – 0.065 mm (0.0010 – 0.0026 in.)
EXAMPLE: The No.25 spacers are installed,
and the measured backlash is 0.110 mm (0.0043 in.).
Replace the No.25 spacers with new No.15 spacers.
New spacer thickness
No.
A01918
1186
01
03
05
07
09
Thickness
No. Thickness
1.74 (0.0685) 11 1.84 (0.0724)
1.76 (0.0693) 13 1.86 (0.0732)
1.78 (0.0701) 15 1.88 (0.0740)
1.80 (0.0709) 17 1.90 (0.0748)
1.82 (0.0717) 19 1.92 (0.0756)
No.
Thickness
21 1.94 (0.0764)
23 1.96 (0.0772)
25 1.98 (0.0780)
27 2.00 (0.0787)
29 2.02 (0.0795)
mm (in.)
No.
Thickness
31 2.04 (0.0803)
33 2.06 (0.0811)
35 2.08 (0.0819)
37 2.10 (0.0827)
39 2.12 (0.0835)
EM–15
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
TIMING BELT
EM083–03
COMPONENTS
64 (650, 47)
64 (650, 47)
Engine Moving Control Rod
52 (530, 38)
Ground Strap Connector
No.2 RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Generator Drive Belt
PS Pump Drive Belt
RH Front Fender Apron Seal
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
S05284
Author:
Date:
1187
EM–16
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
Generator Wire
Generator Connector
Generator
*1
Gasket
Wire
Clamp
Wire
Clamp
No.2 Timing Belt
Cover
Timing Belt
No.1 Timing Belt
Cover
Timing Belt Guide
Crankshaft
Pulley
*1 Gasket
High–Tension Cord
108 (1,100, 80)
Spark Plug
Wire Clamp
18 (180, 13)
Wire Clamp
Wire Clamp
Tension Spring
Camshaft Timing Pulley
54 (550, 40)
*2 37 (380, 27)
No.1 Idler Pulley
42 (425, 31)
No.2 Idler Pulley
42 (425, 31)
24 (245, 18)
Oil Pump Pulley
Crankshaft Timing Pulley
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
*1 Replace only if damaged
*2 For use with SST
S05937
Author:
Date:
1188
EM–17
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
EM084–04
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE GENERATOR (See page CH–6)
REMOVE RH FRONT WHEEL
REMOVE RH FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
4.
REMOVE PS PUMP DRIVE BELT
Loosen the 2 bolts, and remove the drive belt.
5.
DISCONNECT GROUND STRAP CONNECTOR
S05609
6.
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Remove the 3 bolts and control rod.
S05249
7.
REMOVE NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and mounting bracket.
8.
REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
(a) Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the clamps on
the cylinder head cover.
(b) Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the spark plug.
(c) Remove the 4 spark plugs.
S05296
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
Disconnect the 2 engine wire clamps from the timing belt
cover.
Remove the 4 bolts and timing belt cover.
S05597
Author:
Date:
1189
EM–18
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
10.
(a)
–
TIMING BELT
SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with timing
mark ”0” of the No.1 timing belt cover.
Turn
S05587
(b)
Check that the hole of the camshaft timing pulley is
aligned with the timing mark of the bearing cap.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°).
S05580
11.
REMOVE TIMING BELT FROM CAMSHAFT TIMING
PULLEY
HINT:
When re–using timing belt:
Affix the matching marks on the timing belt and the camshaft
timing pulley, and the timing belt and the No. 1 timing belt cover.
A02585
(a)
Pry
(b)
Loosen the mounting bolt of the No.1 idler pulley, and shift
the pulley toward the left as far as it will go, and temporarily tighten it.
Remove the timing belt from the camshaft timing pulley.
Move
S05583
12.
(a)
SST
(b)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Using SST, loosen the pulley bolt.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09962–01000,
09963–01000)
Remove the bolt and timing pulley.
SST
S05593
Author:
Date:
1190
EM–19
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
13.
(a)
SST
–
TIMING BELT
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Using SST (and bolt), loosen the pulley bolt.
SST 09213–54015 (91651–60855), 09330–00021
HINT:
S05589
Either of 2 types of pulley may be used, each with its own
bolt size, type A (91651–60885) and type B (part No.
91121–40665).
When using bolt type B, a plate washer must be inserted
between the bolt and SST.
HINT:
When re–using timing belt:
After loosing the crankshaft pulley bolt and matching the ditch
of the crankshaft pulley with the ”0” of the timing mark of No.1
timing belt cover, check that matching mark meets.
A02586
When matchmark is misaligned clockwise:
If the matchmark does not align, align as follows:
(1) Align the matchmark by pulling the timing belt up on
the water pump pulley side while turning the crankshaft pulley counterclockwise.
Pull
Turn
A02587
(2)
Hold
After aligning the matchmark, hold the timing belt.
And turn the crankshaft pulley clockwise, and align
its groove with timing mark ”0” of the No.1 timing belt
cover.
Turn
A02588
When matchmark is misaligned counterclockwise:
If the matchmark does not align, align as follows:
(1) Align the matchmark by pulling the timing belt up on
the No.1 idler pulley side while turning the crankshaft pulley clockwise.
Pull
Turn
A02589
Author:
Date:
1191
EM–20
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
(2)
Hold
(b)
Turn
After aligning the matchmark, hold the timing belt.
And turn the crankshaft pulley counterclockwise,
and align its groove with timing mark ”0” of the No.1
timing belt cover.
Remove the pulley bolt.
A02590
(c)
SST
Using SST, remove the pulley.
SST 09950–50012 (09951–05010, 09952–05010,
09953–05010, 09953–05020, 09954–05020,
09954–05010)
HINT:
S05612
14.
(a)
(b)
(c)
15.
Either of 2 types of pulley may be used, each with its own
bolt size, type A(09954–05020) and type B
(09954–05010).
When re–using timing belt:
Remove the pulley without turning it.
REMOVE NO.1 TIMING BELT COVER
Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor wire from the
clamp on the timing belt cover.
Disconnect the clamp of the crankshaft position sensor
wire from the timing belt cover.
Remove the 4 bolts and timing belt cover.
REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE
S05591
16. REMOVE TIMING BELT
HINT:
When re–using timing belt:
Draw a direction arrow on the timing belt (in the direction of engine revolution), and place matchmarks on the timing belt and
crankshaft timing pulley.
S05944
17.
REMOVE NO.1 IDLER PULLEY AND TENSION
SPRING
Remove the bolt, pulley and tension spring.
18. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and pulley.
S05614
Author:
Date:
1192
EM–21
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
19. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
If the pulley cannot be removed by hand, use SST to remove
the timing pulley.
SST 09950–50012 (09951–05010, 09952–05010,
09953–05010, 09953–05020, 09954–05010)
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the angle sensor of the timing pulley.
SST
S05579
20.
(a)
SST
(b)
REMOVE OIL PUMP PULLEY
Using SST, loosen the pulley nut.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–00500)
Remove the nut and pulley.
S05575
Author:
Date:
1193
EM–22
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
EM085–03
INSPECTION
No!
EM3336
Turn
1.
INSPECT TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt inside out.
Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact with
oil, water or steam.
Do not utilize timing belt tension when installing or removing the mounting bolt of the camshaft timing
pulley.
If there are any defects as shown in the illustration, check these
points:
(a) Premature parting
Check for proper installation.
Check the timing cover gasket for damage and
proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, check to see if
either camshaft or water pump is locked.
(c) If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt face,
check to see if there are nicks on the side of the idler
pulley lock.
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the belt,
check the belt guide and the alignment of each pulley.
(e) If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth, check the timing cover for damage and check gasket has been
installed correctly and for foreign material on the pulley
teeth.
If necessary, replace the timing belt.
2.
(a)
INSPECT IDLER PULLEYS
Visually check the seal portion of the idler pulley for oil
leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the idler pulley.
(b) Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler pulley.
Seal
S01519
3.
(a)
Free Length
P15243
INSPECT TENSION SPRING
Measure the free length of tension spring.
Free length: 42.0 mm (1.654 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the tension spring.
(b) Measure the tension of the tension spring at the specified
installed length.
Installed tension (at 50.5 mm (1.988 in.)):
32 – 37 N (3.25 – 3.75 kgf, 7.2 – 8.3 lbf)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace the tension
spring.
Author:
Date:
1194
EM–23
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
EM086–04
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
SST
(b)
INSTALL OIL PUMP PULLEY
Align the cutouts of the pulley and shaft, and slide on the
pulley.
Using SST, install the pulley nut.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–00500)
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
S05576
2.
(a)
Angle
Sensor
Inward
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Align the timing pulley set key with the key groove of the
pulley.
(b) Slide on the timing pulley, facing the angle sensor inward.
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the angle sensor of the timing pulley.
S05577
3.
(a)
35 mm
INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Install the pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Use the 35 mm (1.38 in.) long bolt.
(b) Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
S05571
4.
42 mm
TEMPORARILY INSTALL NO.1 IDLER PULLEY AND
TENSION SPRING
Align the bracket pin hole with the pivot pin.
Install the pulley with the bolt. Do not tighten the bolt yet.
(a)
(b)
HINT:
Use the 42 mm (1.65 in.) long bolt.
(c) Install the tension spring.
S05616
(d)
Pry
(e)
Pry the pulley toward the left as far as it will go, and tighten
the bolt.
Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
Move
S05926
Author:
Date:
1195
EM–24
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
5.
TEMPORARILY INSTALL TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
The engine should be cold.
(a) Using the crankshaft pulley bolt, turn the crankshaft and
align the timing marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and
oil pump body.
S05574
(b)
(c)
S05944
Remove any oil or water on the crankshaft pulley, oil
pump pulley, water pump pulley, No.1 idler pulley and
No.2 idler pulley, and keep them clean.
Install the timing belt on the crankshaft timing pulley, oil
pump pulley, No.1 idler pulley, water pump pulley and
No.2 idler pulley.
HINT:
When re–using timing belt:
Align the points marked during removal, and install the belt with
the arrow pointing in the direction of engine revolution.
6.
INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE
Install the guide, facing the cup side outward.
S05578
7.
(a)
Length = 660 mm (25.98 in.)
P25230
INSTALL NO.1 TIMING BELT COVER
Check that the timing belt cover gasket has no cracks or
peeling, etc.
If the gasket has cracks or peeling, etc., replace it using these
steps:
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all
the old gasket material.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
(3) Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and
install the gasket evenly to the part of the timing belt
cover shaded black in the illustration.
(4) After installing the gasket, press down on it so that
the adhesive firmly sticks to the timing belt cover.
Author:
Date:
1196
EM–25
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(b)
(c)
(d)
–
TIMING BELT
Install the timing belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Install the clamp of the crankshaft position sensor wire to
the timing belt cover.
Install the crankshaft position sensor wire to the clamp on
the timing belt cover.
A02591
8.
(a)
SST
(b)
SST
S05588
SST
Fulcrum
Length
SST
S05592
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the pulley,
and slide on the pulley.
Using SST (and bolt), install the pulley bolt.
SST 09213–54015 (91651–60855),09330–00021
Torque: 108 N·m (1,100 kgf·cm, 80 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Either of 2 types of pulley may be used, each with its own bolt
size, type A (91651–60855) and type B
(part No. 91121–40665).
9.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(a) Align the camshaft knock pin with the knock pin groove of
the pulley, and slide on the timing pulley.
(b) Using SST, install the pulley bolt.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09962–01000,
09963–01000)
Torque:
54 N·m (550 kgf·cm, 40 ft·lbf)
37 N·m (380 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf) for use with SST
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 340 mm (13.39
in.).
10.
(a)
SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with timing
mark ”0” of the No.1 timing belt cover.
Turn
S05587
Author:
Date:
1197
EM–26
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
(b)
Using SST, turn the camshaft, and align the hole of the
camshaft timing pulley with the timing mark of the bearing
cap.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–01000)
11.
CONNECT TIMING BELT TO CAMSHAFT TIMING
PULLEY
SST
S05594
HINT:
A02592
When re–using timing belt:
Check that the matching marks of the timing belt and the
No.1 timing belt cover meet.
If the matchmark does not align, shift the meshing of the timing
belt and crankshaft timing pulley until they align.
(See page EM–17)
When re–using timing belt:
Align the matchmarks of the timing belt and camshaft timing pulley.
(a)
(b)
Remove any oil or water on the camshaft timing pulley,
and keep it clean.
Connect the timing belt to the camshaft timing pulley, and
checking the tension between the crankshaft timing
pulley and camshaft timing pulley.
12.
(a)
CHECK VALVE TIMING
Loosen the No.1 idler pulley bolt 1/2 turn.
S05582
S05931
Loosen
S05581
Author:
Date:
1198
EM–27
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
(b)
Slowly turn the crankshaft pulley 2 revolutions TDC to
TDC.
NOTICE:
Always turn the crankshaft pulley clockwise.
Turn
S05587
(c)
Check that each pulley aligns with the timing marks as
shown in the illustration.
If the timing marks do not align, remove the timing belt and reinstall it.
S05598
(d)
Slowly turn the crankshaft pulley 1 and 7/8 revolutions,
and align its groove with the mark at 45° BTDC (for No.1
cylinder) of the No.1 timing belt cover.
NOTICE:
Always turn the crankshaft pulley clockwise.
Turn
S05586
(e)
Tighten the mounting bolt of the No.1 idler pulley.
Torque: 42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
S05585
13.
(a)
Length = 735 mm (28.94 in.)
Length = 230 mm (9.06 in.)
S01710
INSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
Check that the timing belt cover gaskets have no cracks
or peeling, etc.
If the gasket has cracks or peeling, etc., replace it using these
steps:
(1) Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all
the old gasket material.
(2) Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Author:
Date:
1199
EM–28
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(3)
(4)
–
TIMING BELT
Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and
install the gasket evenly to the part of the timing belt
cover shaded black in the illustration.
After installing the gasket, press down on it so that
the adhesive firmly sticks to the timing belt cover.
(b)
(c)
14.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Install the belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Install the engine wire clamp.
INSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Install the 4 spark plugs.
Connect the 4 high–tension cords to the spark plugs.
Install the 4 high–tension cords to the clamps on the cylinder head cover.
15.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Install the mounting bracket with the 3 bolts.
Alternately tighten the 3 bolts in several passes.
Torque: 52 N·m (530 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
16.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Temporarily install the control rod with the 3 bolt.
Alternately tighten the 3 bolts in several passes.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
CONNECT GROUND STRAP CONNECTOR
S05596
S05296
17.
S05249
18. INSTALL PS PUMP DRIVE BELT
Install the drive belt with the 2 bolts.
19. INSTALL RH FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
20. INSTALL RH FRONT WHEEL
21. INSTALL GENERATOR (See page CH–16)
S05609
Author:
Date:
1200
EM–29
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM087–03
COMPONENTS
64 (650, 47)
64 (650, 47)
Engine Moving Control Rod
Ground Strap
Connector
52 (530, 38)
Accelerator Cable
No.2 RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Throttle Cable (A/T)
PCV Hose
EVAP Hose
EVAP Hose
Generator Drive Belt
EVAP Hose
VSV
Connector
for EVAP
IAT Sensor
Connector
PS Drive Belt
Gasket
Air Cleaner Cap
RH Front Fender Apron Seal
64 (630, 46)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A02194
Author:
Date:
1201
EM–30
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Ignition Coil and No.2 Intake
Manifold Assembly
(with High–Tension Cord)
Wire Clamp
Ignition Coil Connector
(TMMK Made)
(TMC Made)
19 (195, 14)
Generator Wire
Generator
Connector
Throttle Position
Sensor Connector
Wire
Clamp
Throttle Body
Gasket
ECT Sender
Gauge Connector
IAC Valve
Connector
ECT Sensor
Connector
Heater Water Hose
Generator
Radiator Hose
Water Outlet
Gasket
Noise Filter Connector
Oil Pressure Switch Connector
A/F Sensor Connector (California) or
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Connector (Except California)
No.1 Exhaust
Manifold Heat
Insulator (California)
Gasket
No.1 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
Except California
No.1 Exhaust
Manifold Heat
Insulator
x6
49 (500, 36)
Exhaust Manifold,
No.2 and no.3
Exhaust Manifold
Heat Insulator
Assenbly
(California)
Exhaust Manifold,
No.2 and No.3
Exhaust Manifold
Heat Insulator
Assembly
49 (500, 36)
No.2 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
(TMC Made)
(TMMK Made)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A01562
Author:
Date:
1202
EM–31
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EGR Valve and Vacuum
Modulator
Ground Wire
MAP Sensor
Vacuum Hose
Gasket
VSV Connector
for EGR
Brake Booster
Vacuum Hose
VSV for EGR
Intake
Manifold
Gasket
x6
Fuel Inlet Hose
19 (195, 14)
Fuel Pulsation Damper
Air Hose for Air Assist System (California)
34 (350, 25)
* 29 (300, 21)
13 (130, 9)
Gasket
Spacer
Injector
Connector
O–Ring
Grommet
Intake Manifold
Stay
Engine Wire
Spacer
Injector
(California)
Insulator
O–Ring
PCV Hose
Injector
(Except California)
Insulator
Knock Sensor 1
Connector
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
* For use with SST
A07358
Author:
Date:
1203
EM–32
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Spark Plug
18 (180, 13)
Adjusting Shim
44 (450, 33)
Valve Lifter
Grommet
Keeper
Spring Retainer
Valve Spring
Cylinder Head Cover
Oil Seal
Spring Seat
Valve Guide
Bushing
Gasket
19 (190, 14)
Intake
Camshaft
Exhaust
Camshaft
Valve
Camshaft Bearing Cap
x 10
Camshaft Oil Seal
See page EM–53
1st 49 (500, 36)
2nd Turn 90°
Camshaft Timing Pulley
Camshaft Gear Spring
Camshaft Sub–Gear
Semi–Circular
Plug
54 (550, 40)
(380, 27)
*237
Snap Ring
Wave Washer
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Camshaft Position Sensor Assembly
Wire Clamp
No. 3 Timing Belt Cover
LH Engine
Hanger
Semi–Circular
Plug
Oil Pressure
Switch
Cylinder Head
42 (425, 31)
Wire
Clamp
Cylinder
Head
Gasket
Tension Spring
Timing Belt
No.1 Idler Pulley
*1 Gasket
Wire
Clamp
No.2 Timing Belt Cover
Generator Bracket and
RH Engine Hanger
Assembly
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
*1 Replace only if damaged
*2 For use with SST
Non–reusable part
A07368
Author:
Date:
1204
EM–33
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM0YL–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP (See page EM–69)
REMOVE GENERATOR (See page CH–6)
4.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD
Remove the 3 nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the
exhaust manifold.
Remove the 3 (California) or 5 (Except California) bolts
and No.1 exhaust manifold heat insulator.
(b)
S05282
(c)
Remove the 2 bolts and No.1 exhaust manifold stay.
(d)
TMC Made:
Remove the 2 nuts and No.2 exhaust manifold stay.
TMMK Made:
Remove the bolt, nut and No.2 exhaust manifold stay.
S05281
(e)
TMC
Made
TMMK
Made
S05300
(f)
(g)
(h)
Sensor
Connector
(i)
Clamp
Remove the wire clamp.
California:
Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Except California:
Disconnect the oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) connector.
Remove the 6 nuts, the exhaust manifold, No.2 and No.3
exhaust manifold heat insulators assembly.
S05297
Author:
Date:
1205
EM–34
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(j)
(k)
5.
Wire
Clamp
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
S05548
(d)
(e)
(f)
7.
8.
–
CYLINDER HEAD
California:
Disconnect the A/F sensor connector for the wiring side
from the bracket on the LH engine hanger.
Except California:
Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
connector for the wiring side from the bracket on the LH
engine hanger.
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY (See page SF–32)
REMOVE IGNITION COILS, NO.2 INTAKE MANIFOLD
STAY AND HIGH–TENSION CORDS ASSEMBLY
Disconnect the 2 ignition coil connectors.
Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the 2 clamps
on the cylinder head cover.
Disconnect the 4 high–tension cords from the spark
plugs.
Disconnect the wire clamp from the manifold stay.
TMC Made:
Remove the 2 nuts, 2 bolts, 2 ignition coils, manifold stay
and 4 high–tension cords assembly.
TMMK Made:
Remove the nut, 3 bolts, 2 ignition coils, manifold stay and
4 high–tension cords assembly.
DISCONNECT OIL PRESSURE SWITCH CONNECTOR
DISCONNECT NOISE FILTER CONNECTOR
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(c)
Clamp
(d)
(e)
A01564
Connector
REMOVE WATER OUTLET
Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
Disconnect the ECT sender gauge connector.
Disconnect the radiator hose from the water outlet.
Disconnect the water bypass pipe hose from the water
outlet.
(e) Disconnect the heater water hose from the water outlet.
(f)
Remove the 2 nuts, water outlet and gasket.
10. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY
Remove the bolt, nut and intake manifold stay.
11. REMOVE EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
(a) Disconnect the VSV connector for the EGR.
(b) Disconnect the hose clamp from the bracket on the intake
manifold.
(c) Remove the bolt, and disconnect the VSV for EGR from
the intake manifold.
A07364
Author:
Date:
1206
EM–35
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(d)
Loosen the union nut of the EGR pipe, and remove the
bolt, 2 nuts, the EGR valve, vacuum modulator, vacuum
hoses assembly and gasket.
12.
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD
Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the bracket on the
LH side of the intake manifold.
Disconnect the 2 engine wire clamps from the 2 brackets
on the front side of the intake manifold.
A07363
(a)
(b)
A07365
13.
(a)
SST
(b)
DISCONNECT FUEL INLET HOSE FROM DELIVERY
PIPE
Using SST, loosen the fuel pulsation damper.
SST 09612–24014 (09617–24011)
Remove the fuel pulsation damper and 2 gaskets, and
disconnect the fuel inlet hose from the delivery pipe.
S05981
(a)
14.
(a)
(c)
(b)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
Disconnect the MAP sensor vacuum hose from the gas
filter.
Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the intake manifold.
Disconnect the PCV hose from the intake manifold.
S05990
(d)
(d)
(e)
Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the 2 ground wires
from the intake manifold.
Disconnect the knock sensor 1 connector.
(e)
A07360
Author:
Date:
1207
EM–36
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(f)
15.
Remove the 6 bolts, 2 nuts, intake manifold and gasket.
California:
REMOVE AIR HOSE FOR AIR ASSIST SYSTEM
Disconnect the air hose from the cylinder head port, and remove the air hose.
A07359
16.
(a)
(b)
S06000
REMOVE DELIVERY PIPE AND INJECTORS
Disconnect the 4 injector connectors.
Remove the 2 bolts and delivery pipe together with the 4
injectors.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the injectors when removing the delivery pipe.
(c) Remove the 4 insulators (except California) and 2
spacers from the cylinder head.
(d) Pull out the 4 injectors from the delivery pipe.
(e) California:
Remove the 2 O–rings, insulator and grommet from each
injector.
(f)
Except California:
Remove the O–ring and grommet from each injector.
17. DISCONNECT TIMING BELT FROM CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY (See page EM–17)
18. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(See page EM–17)
19. REMOVE NO.1 IDLER PULLEY AND TENSION
SPRING
Remove the bolt, pulley and tension spring.
20. REMOVE NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 3 bolts and timing and cover.
S05962
Author:
Date:
1208
EM–37
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
A02593
S05933
Knock
Pin
CYLINDER HEAD
NOTICE:
Support the timing belt, so the meshing of the crankshaft timing pulley and timing belt does not shift.
Be careful not to drop anything inside the timing belt
cover.
Do not allow the belt to come into contact with oil, water or dust.
21. REMOVE ENGINE HANGERS AND GENERATOR
BRACKET
(a) Remove the 3 bolts, the generator bracket and RH engine
hanger assembly.
(b) Remove the bolt and LH engine hanger.
22. REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
23. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER
Remove the 4 nuts, grommets, head cover and gasket.
HINT:
Arrange the grommets in the correct order, so that they can be
reinstalled into their original positions. This minimizes any possibility of oil leakage due to reuse of the grommets in different
positions.
24. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being removed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head
receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the following steps should be carried out.
(a)
10 – 45°
–
Remove the exhaust camshaft.
(1) Set the knock pin of the intake camshaft at 10 – 45°
BTDC of camshaft angle.
HINT:
The above angle allows No.2 and No.4 cylinder cam lobes of
the exhaust camshaft to push their valve lifters evenly.
P03355
Author:
Date:
1209
EM–38
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
CYLINDER HEAD
(2)
Secure the exhaust camshaft sub–gear to drive
gear with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Drive Gear
Service
Bolt
Sub–Gear
–
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 – 20 mm (0.63 – 0.79 in.)
P03445
HINT:
When removing the camshaft, make sure that the torsional
spring force of the sub–gear has been eliminated by the above
operation.
(3) Remove the 2 bolts and rear bearing cap.
P03356
(4)
3
NOTICE:
Do not remove the No.3 bearing cap bolts at this stage.
(5) Remove the No.1, No.2 and No.4 bearing caps.
4
5
6
1
Uniformly loosen and remove the 6 bolts on the
No.1, No.2 and No.4 bearing caps in several
passes, in the sequence shown.
2
P03241
(6)
Alternately loosen and remove the 2 bolts on the
No.3 bearing cap.
HINT:
P03357
As the 2 No.3 bearing cap bolts are loosened, make sure
that the camshaft is lifted out straight and level.
If the camshaft is not being lifted out straight and level, retighten the 2 No.3 bearing cap bolts. Then reverse the order of above steps from (6) to (1) and reset the knock pin
of the intake camshaft at 10 – 45° BTDC, and repeat
steps from (2) to (6) once again.
NOTICE:
Do not pry on or attempt to force the camshaft with a tool
or other object.
(7) Remove the No.3 bearing cap and exhaust camshaft.
Author:
Date:
1210
EM–39
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(b)
80 – 115°
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Remove the intake camshaft.
(1) Set the knock pin of the intake camshaft at 80 –
115° BTDC of camshaft angle.
HINT:
The above angle allows the No.1 and No.3 cylinder cam lobes
of intake camshaft to push their valve lifters evenly.
Knock
Pin
P03358
(2)
Remove the 2 bolts, front bearing cap and oil seal.
(3)
Uniformly loosen and remove the 6 bolts on the
No.1, No.3 and No.4 bearing caps in several
passes, in the sequence shown.
P03359
2
6
1
5
NOTICE:
Do not remove the No.2 bearing cap bolts at this stage.
(4) Remove the No.1, No.3 and No.4 bearing caps.
4
3
P03360
(5)
Alternately loosen and remove the 2 bolts on the
No.2 bearing cap.
HINT:
P03361
As the 2 No.2 bearing cap bolts are loosened, make sure
that the camshaft is lifted out straight and level, after
breaking adhesion on the front bearing cap.
If the camshaft is not being lifted out straight and level, retighten the 2 No.2 bearing cap bolts. Reverse the order
of above steps from (5) to (1) and reset the knock pin of
the intake camshaft at 80 – 115° BTDC, and repeat steps
from (2) to (5) once again.
NOTICE:
Do not pry on or attempt to force the camshaft with a tool
or other object.
(6) Remove the No.2 bearing cap and camshaft.
Author:
Date:
1211
EM–40
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
25. DISASSEMBLE EXHAUST CAMSHAFT
(a) Mount the camshaft in a vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
P05613
SST
(b)
Using SST, turn the sub–gear clockwise, and remove the
service bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–00500)
(c)
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Remove the wave washer, camshaft sub–gear and gear
spring.
Service
Bolt
S01665
S01666
3
5
10
8
2
1
7
9
6
4
26.
(a)
(b)
EM7558
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD
Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
Remove the 2 bolts holding the water bypass pipe to the
cylinder head.
(c) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 cylinder head bolts
in several passes, in the sequence shown.
NOTICE:
Cylinder head warpage or cracking could result from removing bolts in incorrect order.
(d)
Pry
S05971
Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the cylinder
block, and place the cylinder head on wooden blocks on
a bench.
HINT:
If the cylinder head is off, pry between the cylinder head and cylinder block with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the cylinder head and cylinder block.
Author:
Date:
1212
EM–41
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM089–03
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Remove the bolt and sensor assembly.
2.
REMOVE VALVE LIFTERS AND SHIMS
HINT:
Arrange the valve lifters and shims in the correct order.
SST
3.
(a)
(b)
P03265
REMOVE VALVES
Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove the 2
keepers.
SST 09202–70020 (09202–00010)
Remove the spring retainer, valve spring, valve and
spring seat.
HINT:
Arrange the valves, valve springs, spring seats and spring retainers in the correct order.
(c)
Using needle–nose pliers, remove the oil seal.
P03266
Author:
Date:
1213
EM–42
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM08A–04
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
CLEAN TOP SURFACES OF PISTONS AND CYLINDER BLOCK
Turn the crankshaft, and bring each piston to top dead
center (TDC). Using a gasket scraper, remove all the carbon from the piston top surface.
A07356
(b)
A07357
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the cylinder block surface.
(c) Using compressed air, blow carbon and oil from the bolt
holes.
CAUTION:
Protect your eyes when using high–pressure compressed
air.
2.
INSPECT TOP SURFACE OF CYLINDER BLOCK FOR
FLATNESS (See page EM–97)
3.
(a)
CLEAN CYLINDER HEAD
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the cylinder block contact surface.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block contact surface.
P03267
(b)
Using a wire brush, remove all the carbon from the combustion chamber.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block contact surface.
P03268
(c)
Using a valve guide bushing brush and solvent, clean all
the guide bushings.
P03149
Author:
Date:
1214
EM–43
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(d)
Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the cylinder head.
4.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD
Inspect for flatness.
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surfaces contacting the cylinder block and the
manifolds for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
P03363
Cylinder Block Side
Cylinder block side
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Manifold side
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cylinder head.
Intake Manifold Side
Exhaust Manifold Side
Z02749
(b)
Inspect for cracks.
Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion chamber,
intake ports, exhaust ports and cylinder block surface for
cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
P03269
5.
(a)
(b)
CLEAN VALVES
Using a gasket scraper, chip off any carbon from the valve
head.
Using a wire brush, thoroughly clean the valve.
EM0580
Author:
Date:
1215
EM–44
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
6.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE STEMS AND GUIDE BUSHINGS
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
guide bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
6.010 – 6.030 mm (0.2366 – 0.2374 in.)
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the valve
stem.
Valve stem diameter:
Z02754
(c)
Intake
5.970 – 5.985 mm (0.2350 – 0.2356 in.)
Exhaust
5.965 – 5.980 mm (0.2348 – 0.2354 in.)
Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement from the
guide bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
Z00052
Intake
0.025 – 0.060 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 – 0.065 mm (0.0012 – 0.0026 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
Intake
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the valve and
guide bushing. (See page EM–50)
7.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT AND GRIND VALVES
Grind the valve enough to remove pits and carbon.
Check that the valve is ground to the correct valve face
angle.
Valve face angle: 44.5°
44.5°
Z00054
(c)
Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
0.8 – 1.2 mm (0.031 – 0.047 in.)
Minimum margin thickness: 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than minimum, replace the valve.
Margin Thickness
EM0181
Author:
Date:
1216
EM–45
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(d)
Overall Length
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Check the valve overall length.
Standard overall length:
Intake
97.40 – 97.80 mm (3.8346 – 3.8504 in.)
Exhaust
98.25 – 98.65 mm (3.8681 – 3.8839 in.)
Minimum overall length:
EM2534
Intake
97.1 mm (3.823 in.)
Exhaust
98.0 mm (3.858 in.)
If the overall length is less than minimum, replace the valve.
(e) Check the surface of the valve stem tip for wear.
If the valve stem tip is worn, resurface the tip with a grinder or
replace the valve.
NOTICE:
Do not grind off more than the minimum length.
EM0255
45° Carbide
Cutter
8.
(a)
INSPECT AND CLEAN VALVE SEATS
Using a 45° carbide cutter, resurface the valve seats.
Remove only enough metal to clean the seats.
(b)
Check the valve seating position.
Apply a light coat of prussian blue (or white lead) to the
valve face. Lightly press the valve against the seat. Do not
rotate valve.
Check the valve face and seat for the following:
If blue appears 360° around the face, the valve is
concentric. If not, replace the valve.
If blue appears 360° around the valve seat, the
guide and face are concentric. If not, resurface the
seat.
Check that the seat contact is in the middle of the
valve face with the following width:
1.0 – 1.4 mm (0.039 – 0.055 in.)
P03272
(c)
Width
Z00055
Author:
Date:
1217
EM–46
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
45°
30°
–
CYLINDER HEAD
If not, correct the valve seats as follows:
(1) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use 30°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
1.0 – 1.4 mm
Z02852
(2)
75°
If the seating is too low on the valve face, use 75°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
45°
1.0 – 1.4 mm
Z02853
(d)
(e)
Hand–lap the valve and valve seat with an abrasive compound.
After hand–lapping, clean the valve and valve seat.
P03273
9.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE SPRINGS
Using a steel square, measure the deviation of the valve
spring.
Maximum deviation: 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
If the deviation is greater than maximum, replace the valve
spring.
Deviation
EM0988
(b)
Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of the
valve spring.
Free length: 40.95 – 42.80 mm (1.6122 – 1.6850 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the valve spring.
EM0801
Author:
Date:
1218
EM–47
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(c)
Using a spring tester, measure the tension of the valve
spring at the specified installed length.
Installed tension:
164 – 189 N (16.7 – 19.3 kgf, 36.8 – 42.5 lbf)
at 34.7 mm (1.366 in.)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace the valve
spring.
EM0281
10.
(a)
INSPECT CAMSHAFTS
Inspect the circle runout.
(1) Place the camshaft on V–blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at
the center journal.
Maximum circle runout: 0.04 mm (0.0016 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, replace the camshaft.
EM1628
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height.
Standard cam lobe height:
Intake
42.01 – 42.11 mm (1.6539 – 1.6579 in.)
Exhaust
40.06 – 40.16 mm (1.5772 – 1.5811 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
EM2011
Intake
41.90 mm (1.6496 in.)
Exhaust
39.95 mm (1.5728 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than minimum, replace the camshaft.
(c) Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
Journal diameter:
26.959 – 26.975 mm (1.0614 – 1.0620 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance.
EM2538
(d)
Using vernier calipers, measure the free distance between the gear spring ends.
Free distance: 22.5 – 22.9 mm (0.886 – 0.902 in.)
If the free distance is not as specified, replace the gear spring.
Free Distance
EM3322
Author:
Date:
1219
EM–48
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(e)
Inspect the journal oil clearance.
(1) Clean the bearing caps and camshaft journals.
(2) Check that bearings for flaking and scoring.
If the bearings are damaged, replace the bearing caps and cylinder head as a set.
(3) Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
(4) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the camshaft journals.
Plastigage
EM3371
(5) Install the bearing caps. (See page EM–53)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the camshaft.
(6) Remove the bearing caps.
P00259
(7) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.025 – 0.062 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps and cylinder head
as a set.
(8) Completely remove the Plastigage.
EM3310
(f)
Inspect the camshaft thrust clearance.
(1) Install the camshaft. (See page EM–53)
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
Intake
0.045 – 0.100 mm (0.0018 – 0.0039 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 – 0.085 mm (0.0012 – 0.0033 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
P00263
Intake
0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps and cylinder
head as a set.
Author:
Date:
1220
EM–49
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(g)
EM3308
Inspect the camshaft gear backlash.
(1) Install the camshafts without installing the exhaust
cam sub–gear. (See page EM–53)
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash.
Standard backlash:
0.020 – 0.200 mm (0.0008 – 0.0079 in.)
Maximum backlash: 0.30 mm (0.0188 in.)
If the backlash is greater then maximum, replace the camshafts.
11.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE LIFTERS AND LIFTER BORES
Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter:
31.000 – 31.018 mm (1.2205 – 1.2212 in.)
P03368
(b)
EM2196
Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter.
Lifter diameter:
30.966 – 30.976 mm (1.2191 – 1.2195 in.)
(c) Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the lifter
bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.024 – 0.052 mm (0.0009 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the lifter.
If necessary, replace the cylinder head.
12. INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the
surface contacting the cylinder head for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the manifold.
S06013
13. INSPECT EXHAUST MANIFOLD
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the
surface contacting the cylinder head for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the manifold.
S05606
Author:
Date:
1221
EM–50
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM08B–03
REPLACEMENT
80 – 100°C
REPLACE VALVE GUIDE BUSHINGS
(a) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 – 100°C (176 –
212°F).
P03270
(b)
Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bushing.
SST 09201–10000 (09201–01060),
09950–70010 (09951–07100)
(c)
Using a caliper gauge, measure the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head.
SST
SST
P13987
P03365
Both intake and exhaust
Bushing bore diameter
mm (in.) Bushing size
10.985 – 11.012
(0.4325 – 0.4335)
Use STD
11.035 – 11.062
(0.4344 – 0.4355)
Use O/S 0.05
Intake
HINT:
Different the bushings are used for the intake and exhaust.
(e) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 – 100°C (176 –
212°F).
Exhaust
38.5 mm
(1.516 in.)
(d) Select a new guide bushing (STD or O/S 0.05).
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is greater than
11.012 mm (0.4335 in.), machine the bushing bore to the following dimension:
11.035 – 11.062 mm (0.4344 – 0.4355 in.)
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is greater than
11.062 mm (0.4355 in.), replace the cylinder head.
40.5 mm
(1.594 in.)
P03156
Author:
Date:
1222
EM–51
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
SST
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(f)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bushing until there is 8.0 – 8.8 mm (0.315 – 0.346 in.) protruding from
the cylinder head.
SST 09201–10000 (09201–01060),
09950–70010 (09951–07100)
(g)
Using a sharp 6 mm reamer, ream the guide bushing to
obtain the standard specified clearance (See page
EM–42) between the guide bushing and valve stem.
8.0 – 8.8 mm
SST
S07360
Sharp 6 mm
Reamer
P03367
Author:
Date:
1223
EM–52
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM0YM–01
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
1.
(a)
Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all sliding and rotating surfaces.
Replace all gaskets and oil seals with new ones.
INSTALL VALVES
Using SST, push in a new oil seal.
SST 09201–41020
SST
P03274
Intake
Exhaust
Gray
Black
HINT:
The intake valve oil seal is gray and the exhaust valve oil seal
is black.
(b) Install the valve, spring seat, valve spring and spring retainer.
Z02903
(c)
SST
Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the 2
keepers around the valve stem.
SST 09202–70020 (09202–00010)
P03265
(d)
P03276
Using a plastic–faced hammer, lightly tap the valve stem
tip to assure a proper fit.
2.
INSTALL VALVE LIFTERS AND SHIMS
(a) Install the valve lifter and shim.
(b) Check that the valve lifter rotates smoothly by hand.
3.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Install the sensor assembly with the bolt.
Torque: 9.5 N·m (97 kgf·cm, 84 in.·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1224
EM–53
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM08D–04
INSTALLATION
1.
PLACE CYLINDER HEAD ON CYLINDER BLOCK
(a) Place a new cylinder head gasket on the cylinder block.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Place the cylinder head on the cylinder head gasket.
A07355
8
6
1
3
9
10
4
2
5
7
2.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD BOLTS
HINT:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 progressive
steps (steps (b) and (d)).
If any cylinder head bolt is broken or deformed, replace
it.
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(b) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 cylinder head bolts
and plate washers in several passes, in the sequence
shown.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
If any one of the cylinder head bolts does not meet the torque
specification, replace the cylinder head bolt.
Z02750
90°
(c)
(d)
90°
Front
(e)
Painted
Mark
(f)
S01690
(g)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
P03279
Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt head with paint.
Retighten the cylinder head bolts 90° in the numerical order shown.
Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to the
front.
Install the 2 bolts holding the water bypass pipe to the cylinder head.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Connect the camshaft position sensor connector.
INSTALL SPARK PLUG TUBES
Clean the cylinder head tube holes of any residual adhesive, oil or foreign particles. Remove any oil with kerosene
or gasoline.
Screw the threads of the spark plug tube coated with
adhesive into the cylinder head.
Using the spark plug tube nut and a 30 mm socket
wrench, tighten the spark plug tubes.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1225
EM–54
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
4.
ASSEMBLE EXHAUST CAMSHAFT
(a) Mount the camshaft in a vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
P05617
(b)
Wave Washer
Install the camshaft gear spring, camshaft sub–gear and
wave washer.
HINT:
Align the pins on the gears with the spring ends.
Sub–Gear
Gear Spring
Z02838
(c)
Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
S01666
(d)
SST
Sub–Gear
Main Gear
Turn
Service
Bolt
S01664
Using SST, align the holes of the camshaft drive gear and
sub–gear by turning camshaft sub–gear clockwise, and
install a service bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–00500)
(e) Align the gear teeth of the drive gear and sub–gear, and
tighten the service bolt.
5.
INSTALL CAMSHAFTS
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be kept level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head
receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the following steps should be carried out.
Author:
Date:
1226
EM–55
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(a)
80 –115°
Knoc k
Pin
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Install the intake camshaft.
(1) Apply MP grease to the thrust portion of the camshaft.
(2) Place the intake camshaft at 80 – 115° BTDC of
camshaft angle on the cylinder head.
HINT:
The above angle arrows the No.1 and No.3 cylinder cam lobes
of the intake camshaft to push their valve lifters evenly.
P03369
(3)
Apply seal packing to the No.1 bearing cap as
shown.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
2 – 3 mm
(0.08 – 0.12 in.)
Seal
Packing
EM3373
(4)
Install the bearing caps in their proper locations.
P03370
(5)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(6) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap
bolts in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 19 N·m (190 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
7
8
1
2
5
6
3
4
9
10
P03371
(7) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(8) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal.
SST 09223–46011
SST
P03372
Author:
Date:
1227
EM–56
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(b)
10 – 45°
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Install the exhaust camshaft.
(1) Set the knock pin of the intake camshaft at 10 – 45°
BTDC of camshaft angle.
HINT:
The above angle allows the No.2 and No.4 cylinder cam lobes
of the exhaust camshaft to push their valve lifters evenly.
Knock
Pin
P03281
(2)
Assembly
Reference Mark
(3)
Timing
Mark
P03373
(4)
Apply MP grease to the thrust portion of the camshaft.
Engage the exhaust camshaft gear to the intake
camshaft gear by matching the timing marks on
each gear.
Roll down the exhaust camshaft onto the bearing
journals while engaging gears with each other.
NOTICE:
There are also assembly reference marks on each gear as
shown in the illustration. Do not use these marks.
(5) Turn the intake camshaft clockwise or counterclockwise a little until the exhaust camshaft sits in the
bearing journals evenly without rocking the camshaft on the bearing journals.
NOTICE:
It is very important to replace the camshaft in the bearing
journals evenly while tightening bearing caps in the subsequent steps.
(6)
Install the bearing caps in their proper locations.
P03374
(7)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(8) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap
bolts in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 19 N·m (190 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
10
6
2
9
5
1
4
3
8
7
P03375
Author:
Date:
1228
EM–57
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
Drive Gear
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(9) Remove the service bolt.
6.
CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(See page EM–4)
Turn the camshaft and position the cam lobe upward, and inspect and adjust the valve clearance.
Service
Bolt
Sub–Gear
P03445
7.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SEMI–CIRCULAR PLUGS
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
Apply seal packing to the semi–circular plug grooves.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
(c)
Install the 2 semi–circular plugs to the cylinder head.
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
Apply seal packing to the cylinder head as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
(c)
(d)
Install the gasket to the head cover.
Install the head cover with the 4 grommets and nuts. Uniformly tighten the nuts in several passes.
Torque: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 33 ft·lbf)
Seal Packing
EM7797
P03282
: Seal Packing
P03283
Marking
15°
15°
HINT:
Install the grommets so that their markings are as shown in the
illustration.
S05932
Author:
Date:
1229
EM–58
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
9.
(a)
Adhesive
(b)
10.
P13638
(a)
(b)
S05962
California
(b)
New O–Ring
New O–Ring
(c)
New Grommet
(d)
Except California
CYLINDER HEAD
INSTALL OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00080, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Install the oil pressure switch.
INSTALL ENGINE HANGERS AND GENERATOR
BRACKET
Install the generator bracket and RH engine hanger assembly with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
Install the LH engine hanger with the bolt.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
11. INSTALL NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
Install the timing belt cover with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
12. TEMPORARILY INSTALL NO.1 IDLER PULLEY AND
TENSION SPRING (See page EM–23)
13. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(See page EM–23)
14. CONNECT TIMING BELT TO CAMSHAFT TIMING
PULLEY (See page EM–23)
15.
(a)
New Insulator
–
INSTALL INJECTORS AND DELIVERY PIPE
California:
Install a new insulator and grommet to each injector.
Except California:
Install a new grommet to each injector.
California:
Apply a light coat of gasoline onto 2 new O–rings, and
install them to each injector.
Except California:
Apply a light coat of gasoline onto a new O–ring, and
install it to each injector.
New
O–Ring
New Grommet
Z09141
Author:
Date:
1230
EM–59
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(e)
Upward
(f)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
While turning the injector clockwise and counterclockwise, push it to the delivery pipe. Install the 6 injectors.
Position the injector connector upward.
Turn
Connector
Push
S06009
(g)
Install the 2 spacers and 4 new insulators (Except California) to the cylinder head.
(h)
Attach the 4 injectors together with the delivery pipe to the
cylinder head.
Temporarily install the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to
the cylinder head.
Spacer
New Insulator
S05935
(i)
S06002
(j)
Check that the injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT:
If injectors do not rotate smoothly, the probable cause is incorrect installation of O–rings. Replace the O–rings.
(k) Position the injector connector upward.
Turn
Upward
Connector
S06003
(l)
Tighten the 2 bolts holding the delivery pipe to the cylinder
head.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
S06001
Author:
Date:
1231
EM–60
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
CYLINDER HEAD
(m) Connect the 4 injector connectors.
HINT:
The No.1 and No.3 injector connectors are brown, and the No.2
and No.4 injector connectors are gray.
No.1
Gray
–
No.2
No.4
No.3
Brown
A07362
16.
California:
INSTALL AIR HOSE FOR AIR ASSIST SYSTEM
Connect the air hose to the cylinder head port.
California
A07361
17.
(a)
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
Install a new gasket and the intake manifold with the 6
bolts and 2 nuts. Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts in
several passes.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(b)
(c)
Connect the MAP sensor vacuum hose to the gas filter.
Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the intake
manifold.
Connect the PCV hose to the intake manifold.
A07359
(b)
(d)
(d)
(c)
S05990
(e)
(e)
(f)
Connect the 2 ground wires to the intake manifold with the
2 bolts.
Connect the knock sensor 1 connector.
(f)
A07360
Author:
Date:
1232
EM–61
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
18.
(a)
(b)
SST
Fulcrum
Length
S05982
–
CYLINDER HEAD
CONNECT FUEL INLET HOSE TO DELIVERY PIPE
Temporarily connect the fuel inlet hose with 2 new gaskets and fuel pulsation damper.
Using SST, tighten the fuel pulsation damper.
SST 09612–24014 (09617–24011)
Torque:
34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf) for use with SST
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (1.181 in.).
19. INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
(a) Install the 2 engine wire clamps to the 2 brackets on the
front side of the intake manifold.
(b) Install the engine wire clamp to the bracket on the LH side
of the intake manifold.
A07365
20.
(a)
INSTALL EGR VALVE AND VACUUM MODULATOR
Install a new gasket, the EGR valve, EGR pipe and vacuum modulator assembly with the union nut, 2 nuts and
bolt.
Torque:
13.3 N·m (136 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf) for nut
61.2 N·m (624 kgf·cm, 45 ft·lbf) for union nut
A07363
(b)
Clamp
Connector
Install the hose clamp to the bracket on the intake manifold.
(c) Install the VSV for the EGR with the bolt.
(d) Connect the VSV connector for the EGR.
21. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY
Install the intake manifold stay with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 39 N·m (398 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
A07364
22.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
A01564
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
23.
24.
INSTALL WATER OUTLET
Install a new gasket and the water outlet with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
Connect the radiator hose to the water outlet.
Connect the water bypass pipe hose to the water outlet.
Connect the heater water hose to the water outlet.
Connect the ECT sensor connector.
Connect the ECT sender gauge connector.
CONNECT OIL PRESSURE SWITCH CONNECTOR
CONNECT NOISE FILTER CONNECTOR
Author:
Date:
1233
EM–62
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
25.
Wire
Clamp
S05548
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
26.
27.
(a)
Sensor
Connector
(b)
Clamp
S05297
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
INSTALL IGNITION COILS AND NO.2 INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY ASSEMBLY
TMC Made:
Install the 2 ignition coils and manifold stay assembly with
the 2 nuts and 2 bolts.
Torque:
21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf) for 12 mm head
42 N·m (428 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf) for 14 mm head
TMMK Made:
Install the 2 ignition coils and manifold stay assembly with
the nut and 3 bolts.
Torque:
21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf) for 12 mm head
42 N·m (428 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf) for 14 mm head
Install the wire clamp to the manifold stay.
Connect the 4 high–tension cords to the spark plugs.
Install the 4 high–tension cords to the 2 clamps on the cylinder head cover.
Connect the 2 ignition coil connectors.
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY (See page SF–34)
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD
California:
Install the A/F sensor connector for the wiring side to the
bracket to the LH engine hanger.
Except California:
Install the heated oxygen sensor for the wiring side to the
bracket to the LH engine hanger.
Attach the exhaust manifold to the front exhaust pipe.
Install a new gasket, the exhaust manifold, No.2 and No.3
exhaust manifold heat insulators assembly with the 6
nuts. Uniformly tighten the nuts in several passes.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
Install the wire clamp.
California:
Connect the A/F sensor connector.
Except California:
Connect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
connector.
Install the No.1 exhaust manifold stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
S05281
Author:
Date:
1234
EM–63
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(i)
TMC
Made
TMMK
Made
(j)
S05300
(k)
(l)
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
S05282
–
CYLINDER HEAD
TMC Made:
Install the No.2 exhaust manifold stay with the 2 nuts.
Torque:
42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf) for manifold side
58 N·m (591 kgf·cm, 43 ft·lbf) for block side
TMMK Made:
Install the No.2 exhaust manifold stay with the bolt and
nut.
Torque:
42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf) for manifold side
41.5 N·m (423 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf) for block side
Install the No.1 exhaust manifold heat insulator with the
3 (California) or 5 (Except California) bolts.
Install 3 new nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the exhaust manifold.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
INSTALL GENERATOR (See page CH–16)
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CASE (See page EM–75)
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AND OIL LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1235
EM–64
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
ENGINE UNIT
EM0YV–01
COMPONENTS
Upper Radiator Support
Radiator Reservoir Hose
Upper Radiator
Support
No.2 Electric
Cooling Fan
Connector
Hood
EVAP Hose
Upper Radiator
Hose
EVAP Hose
Radiator
Assembly
Washer Hose
for Windshield
No.1 Electric
Cooling Fan
Connector
VSV
Connector
for EVAP
PCV Hose
Air
Cleaner
Cap
EVAP
Hose
ECT Switch
Connector
Lower Radiator
Support
IAT Sensor
Connector
Lower Radiator Hose
Generator Drive Belt
Air Filter
A/C Compressor
Connector
Air Cleaner
Case
A/C Compressor
Battery
Hold–Down
Clamp
Cylinder Block Insulator
Oil Cooler Hose (A/T)
Cruise
Control
Actuator
Connector
Cruise Control Actuator
Battery
Clamp
RH Front Fender
Aplon Seal
Battery Tray
PS Oil Pressure Switch
Connector
LH Front Fender Apron Seal
PS Pump Drive Belt
PS Pump
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Support
Bracket
Gasket
Front Exhaust Pipe
62 (630, 46)
Support Bracket
Support Stay
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A02195
Author:
Date:
1236
EM–65
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
Engine Wire
No.2 Instrument Panel
Under Cover
Front Door Inside Scuff Plate
Cowl Side Trim
A01658
Engine Wire Clamp
MAP Sensor
Connector
Brake Booster
Vacuum Hose
DLC1
MAP Sensor
Vacuum Hose
Fuel Inlet Hose
Wire
Clamp
Engine
Wire
Ground
Cable (M/T)
Ground Strap
Connector
Generator
Wire
Ground Strap Connector
Wire
Clamp
Generator
Connector
Starter
Connector
Heater
Hose
Ground
Cable (A/T)
Starter
Cable
Engine
Wire
Protector
A01565
Author:
Date:
1237
EM–66
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
M/T
Transaxle Shift
Control Cable
Engine Wire
Engine Moving Control Rod
64 (650, 47)
Starter
64 (650, 47)
64 (650, 47)
Clutch Release Cylinder and Tube
Rear Engine
mounting
Insulator
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Bracket
52 (530, 38)
64 (650, 47)
Engine and
Transaxle Assembly
64 (650, 47)
Transaxle
Shift
Control
Cable
(A/T)
66 (670, 49)
Front Engine
Mounting Insulator
64 (650, 47)
Tie Rod End
RH Drive Shaft
294 (3,000, 217)
TMC Made
80 (820, 59)
TMMK Made
44 (450, 32) for Silver Color
66 (670, 49) for Green Color
Lock Cap
LH Drive Shaft
49 (500, 36)
Lower Suspension Arm
127 (1,300, 94)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A02188
Author:
Date:
1238
EM–67
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
M/T
RH Stiffener Plate
Intake Manifold
Stay
Engine
No.1 Rear End Plate
No.2 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
88 (900, 65)
Flywheel
(TMMK Made)
x8
LH Stiffener Plate
(TMC Made)
Clutch Disk
Exhaust Pipe Bracket
Clutch Cover
x6
19 (195, 14)
Oil Pan
Insulator
No.2 Rear End Plate
Engine Wire
Back–Up Light Switch Connector
VSS Connector
64(650, 47)
Wire Clamp
64(650, 47)
Ground Strap
No.1 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
64(650, 47)
Transaxle
64(650, 47)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
S05316
Author:
Date:
1239
EM–68
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
A/T
RH Stiffener Plate
Intake Manifold
Stay
Engine
No.1 Rear End Plate
No.2 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
Drive Plate
Front Spacer
(TMMK Made)
Rear Spacer
LH Stiffener Plate
(TMC Made)
x8
27 (280, 20)
83 (850, 61)
x6
Exhaust Pipe Bracket
Throttle Cable
Oil Pan
Insulator
Engine Wire
66 (670, 48)
No.2 Rear End Plate
Wire Clamp
66 (670, 48)
VSS Connector
Ground Strap
66 (670, 48)
Solenoid Connector
No.1 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
Transaxle
66 (670, 20)
Solenoid Connector
PNP Switch
Connector
Starter
Throttle Cable Clamp
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
A02187
Author:
Date:
1240
EM–69
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
EM08F–04
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
7.
(a)
(b)
8.
9.
10.
11.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
S05251
(e)
(f)
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
REMOVE HOOD
REMOVE FRONT FENDER APRON SEALS
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP
Disconnect the IAT sensor connector.
Disconnect the VSV connector for the EVAP
Disconnect the PCV hose from the cylinder head cover.
Disconnect the EVAP hose from the throttle body.
Disconnect the EVAP hose from the VSV.
Disconnect the 2 clamps, and disconnect the air cleaner
cap from the air cleaner case.
Loosen hose clamp, and disconnect the air cleaner hose
from the throttle body.
Remove the air cleaner cap and hose assembly.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CASE
Remove the air filter.
Remove the 3 bolts and air cleaner case.
REMOVE BATTERY AND TRAY
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
REMOVE RADIATOR (See page CO–18)
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
Remove the 2 bolts holding the support stay to the support bracket.
Remove the 2 bolts holding the support bracket to the
front frame.
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
Remove the 3 nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the
exhaust manifold.
Remove the front exhaust pipe and 2 gaskets.
Remove the nut and support bracket.
DISCONNECT CONNECTORS, WIRES, CABLES,
CLAMPS AND HOSES
Disconnect the generator wire.
Disconnect the generator connector.
Disconnect the wire clamp from the generator.
Disconnect the starter cable.
Disconnect the starter connector.
Disconnect the DLC1 from the bracket.
Author:
Date:
1241
EM–70
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(r)
(s)
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
S05253
14.
15.
16.
17.
–
ENGINE UNIT
Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the bracket on the
RH fender apron.
Disconnect the MAP sensor connector.
Disconnect the wire clamp from the bracket for the MAP
sensor.
Disconnect the 2 ground strap connectors from the RH
fender apron.
Disconnect the 2 ground strap connectors from the LH
fender apron.
Disconnect the engine wire protector clamp from the battery bracket.
Disconnect the engine wire from the clamp on the fuel filter.
Disconnect the ground cable from the transaxle.
Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the intake manifold.
Disconnect the heater hose from the water outlet.
Disconnect the heater hose from the water bypass pipe.
Disconnect the fuel inlet hose from the fuel filter.
Disconnect the MAP sensor vacuum hose from the gas
filter on the intake manifold.
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM CABIN
Remove the under cover.
Disconnect the 3 ECM connectors.
Disconnect the 3 cowl wire connectors from the connectors on the bracket.
Disconnect the grommet from the cowl panel, and pull out
the engine wire.
REMOVE DRIVE SHAFTS (See page SA–17)
DISCONNECT TRANSAXLE CONTROL CABLE(S)
FROM TRANSAXLE
M/T:
REMOVE STARTER (See page ST–5)
M/T:
DISCONNECT CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER AND
TUBE FROM TRANSAXLE
Author:
Date:
1242
EM–71
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
18.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
–
ENGINE UNIT
DISCONNECT A/C COMPRESSOR FROM ENGINE
Disconnect the A/C compressor connector.
Remove the drive belt.
Remove the 3 bolts, and disconnect the A/C compressor
from the engine.
Remove the cylinder block insulator.
Connector
S05250
19.
(a)
(b)
(c)
DISCONNECT PS PUMP FROM ENGINE
Disconnect the PS oil pressure switch connector.
Loosen the 2 bolts, and remove the drive belt.
Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the PS pump from
the engine.
20.
REMOVE BOLTS HOLDING TRANSAXLE TO LH ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
S05246
M/T
M/T:
Remove the 3 bolts.
S05254
A/T:
Remove the 4 bolts.
A/T
S04616
21.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NUTS HOLDING REAR ENGINE MOUNTING
BRACKET TO FRONT FRAME
Remove the 2 hole plugs.
Remove the 3 nuts.
S05247
Author:
Date:
1243
EM–72
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
22.
REMOVE BOLTS HOLDING FRONT ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR TO FRONT FRAME
Remove the 3 bolts.
S05248
23.
ATTACH ENGINE SLING DEVICE TO ENGINE HANGERS
Attach the engine chain hoist to the engine hangers.
CAUTION:
Do not attempt to hang the engine by hooking the chain to
any other part.
S05323
24. REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Remove the 3 bolts and control rod.
S05249
25.
Lift
A06578
REMOVE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
FROM VEHICLE
(a) Lift the engine out of the vehicle slowly and carefully.
NOTICE:
Make sure the engine is clear of all wiring, hoses and
cables.
(b) Place the engine and transaxle assembly onto the stand.
26. REMOVE FRONT ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
FROM ENGINE
Remove the 4 bolts and mounting insulator.
27. REMOVE REAR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
FROM ENGINE
Remove the 4 bolts, the mounting insulator.
28. REMOVE NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
FROM ENGINE
Remove the 3 bolts and mounting bracket.
29. A/T:
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE FROM THROTTLE
BODY
Author:
Date:
1244
EM–73
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
30.
TMMK
Made
TMC
Made
S05526
A/T:
REMOVE STARTER (See page ST–5)
31. DISCONNECT CONNECTORS
(a) Disconnect the VSS connector.
(b) M/T:
Disconnect the back–up light switch connector.
(c) A/T:
Disconnect the PNP switch connector.
(d) A/T:
Disconnect the 2 solenoid connectors.
32. REMOVE NO.1 EXHAUST MANIFOLD STAY
Remove the 2 bolts and manifold stay.
33. REMOVE NO.2 EXHAUST MANIFOLD STAY AND LH
STIFFENER PLATE
(a) TMC Made:
Remove the 2 nuts and manifold stay.
(b) TMMK Made:
Remove the bolt, nut and manifold stay.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and stiffener plate.
34. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY
Remove the 2 bolts and intake manifold stay.
35. REMOVE RH STIFFENER PLATE
Remove the 4 bolts and stiffener plate.
A02198
36.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE BRACKET, OIL PAN INSULATOR AND NO.2 REAR END PLATE
Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust pipe bracket.
Remove the 2 bolts, oil pan insulator and rear end plate.
S05530
37.
(a)
(b)
A/T:
REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH BOLTS
Turn the crankshaft pulley bolt to gain access to each bolt.
Hold the crankshaft pulley bolt with a wrench, and remove
the 6 bolts.
Turn
S05529
Author:
Date:
1245
EM–74
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
Wire
Bracket
38.
(a)
(b)
39.
–
ENGINE UNIT
REMOVE TRANSAXLE
Remove the 4 bolts, ground strap and wire bracket.
Remove the transaxle together with the torque converter
clutch (A/T) from the engine.
M/T:
REMOVE CLUTCH COVER AND DISC
Ground
Strap
S05531
40.
M/T:
REMOVE FLYWHEEL
Remove the 8 bolts and flywheel.
41. A/T:
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE
Remove the 8 bolts, front spacer, drive plate and rear spacer.
42. REMOVE NO.1 REAR END PLATE
Remove the bolt and end plate.
M/T
S05314
Author:
Date:
1246
EM–75
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
EM08G–04
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO.1 REAR END PLATE
Install the end plate with the bolt.
Torque: 9.3 N·m (95 kgf·cm, 82 in.·lbf)
2.
(a)
M/T:
INSTALL FLYWHEEL
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
EM7333
(b)
(c)
M/T
1
7
3
6
3.
5
4
8
2
4.
Z18989
5.
Wire
Bracket
6.
(a)
(b)
Install the flywheel on the crankshaft.
Install and uniformly tighten the 8 bolts in several passes,
in the sequence shown.
Torque: 88 N·m (900 kgf·cm, 65 ft·lbf)
A/T:
INSTALL DRIVE PLATE (See step 2)
Torque: 83 N·m (850 kgf·cm, 61 ft·lbf)
M/T:
INSTALL CLUTCH DISC AND COVER
A/T:
CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH INSTALLATION (A140E: See page AX–25)
INSTALL TRANSAXLE TO ENGINE
Attach the transaxle to the engine.
Install the ground strap, wire bracket and 4 bolts.
Torque:
46 N·m (470 kgf·cm, 34 ft·lbf) for 14 mm head
64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf) for 17 mm head
Ground
Strap
S05531
Author:
Date:
1247
EM–76
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
7.
A/T
(a)
Black
Colored
Bolt
(b)
Turn
Z19014
–
ENGINE UNIT
A/T:
INSTALL TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH BOLTS
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Hold the crankshaft pulley bolt with a wrench, and install
the 6 bolts evenly.
Torque: 27 N·m (280 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
HINT:
First tighten the black colored bolt, install the other bolts.
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL NO.2 REAR END PLATE, OIL PAN INSULATOR AND EXHAUST PIPE BRACKET
Install the oil pan insulator to the rear end plate.
Install the rear end plate and exhaust pipe bracket with
the 4 bolts.
Torque:
9.3 N·m (95 kgf·cm, 82 in.·lbf) for 10 mm head
19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf) for 12 mm head
S05530
9.
INSTALL RH STIFFENER PLATE
Install the stiffener plate with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 39 N·m (398 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
10. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY
Install the manifold stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N·m (398 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
A02198
11.
TMMK
Made
(a)
(b)
TMC
Made
S05526
(c)
INSTALL LH STIFFENER PLATE AND NO.2 EXHAUST
MANIFOLD STAY
TMC Made:
Temporarily install the stiffener plate and manifold stay
with the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
TMMK Made:
Temporarily install the stiffener plate and manifold stay
with the 3 bolts and nut.
Tighten the 2 bolts holding the stiffener plate to the transaxle.
Author:
Date:
1248
EM–77
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
Torque:
37 N·m (380 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf) for M/T
42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf) for A/T
(d) TMC Made:
Tighten the nut holding the manifold stay to the cylinder
block.
Torque: 58 N·m (591 kgf·cm, 43 ft·lbf)
(e) TMMK Made:
Tighten the bolt holding the manifold stay to the cylinder
block.
Torque: 42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
(f)
Tighten the nut holding the manifold stay to the exhaust
manifold.
Torque: 42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
12. INSTALL NO.1 EXHAUST MANIFOLD STAY
Install the manifold stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 42 N·m (425 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
13. CONNECT CONNECTORS
(a) Connect the VSS connector.
(b) M/T:
Connect the back–up light switch connector.
(c) A/T:
Connect the PNP switch connector.
(d) A/T:
Connect the 2 solenoid connectors.
14. A/T:
INSTALL STARTER (See page ST–19)
15. A/T:
INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE TO THROTTLE BODY
16. INSTALL NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET TO
ENGINE
Install the mounting insulator with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 52 N·m (530 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
17. INSTALL REAR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR TO
ENGINE
Install the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
18. INSTALL FRONT ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR TO
ENGINE
Install the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1249
EM–78
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
19.
Lower
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
ENGINE UNIT
INSTALL ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY IN
VEHICLE
Attach the engine sling device to the engine hangers.
Lower the engine into the engine compartment.
Tilt the transaxle downward, and lower the engine.
Keep the engine level, and attach front and rear mountings to the front frame.
A06577
20. INSTALL ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Install the control rod with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
S05249
21.
S05248
INSTALL BOLTS HOLDING FRONT ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR TO FRONT FRAME
Install the 3 bolts.
Torque:
TMC made
80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
TMMK made
44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf) for silver color
66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 49 ft·lbf) for green color
22.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL NUTS HOLDING REAR ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR TO FRONT FRAME
Install the 3 nuts.
Torque: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 49 ft·lbf)
Install the 2 hole plugs.
S05247
23.
M/T
INSTALL BOLTS HOLDING LH ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR TO FRONT FRAME
M/T:
Install the 3 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
S05254
Author:
Date:
1250
EM–79
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
A/T:
Install the 4 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
24. REMOVE ENGINE SLING DEVICE
25. CONNECT TRANSAXLE CONTROL CABLE(S) TO
TRANSAXLE
A/T
S04616
26.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL PS PUMP
Install the PS pump with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
Install the drive belt.
Connect the PS oil pressure switch connector.
S05246
27.
(a)
(b)
(c)
28.
Connector
S05250
29.
30.
31.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
32.
S05253
(a)
INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR
Install the cylinder block insulator and A/C compressor
with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 25.5 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
Install the drive belt.
Connect the A/C compressor connector.
M/T:
INSTALL CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER AND TUBE
TO TRANSAXLE
M/T:
INSTALL STARTER (See page ST–19)
INSTALL DRIVE SHAFTS (See page SA–24)
CONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO CABIN
Push in the engine wire through the cowl panel. Install the
grommet.
Connect the 3 engine ECM connectors.
Connect the 3 cowl wire connectors to the connectors on
the bracket.
Install the under cover.
CONNECT CONNECTORS, WIRES, CABLES,
CLAMPS AND HOSES
Connect the generator wire.
Author:
Date:
1251
EM–80
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(r)
(s)
(t)
–
ENGINE UNIT
Connect the generator connector.
Install the wire clamp to the generator.
Connect the starter cable.
Connect the starter connector.
Install the DLC1 to the bracket.
Install the engine wire clamp to the bracket on the RH
fender apron.
Connect the MAP sensor connector.
Install the wire clamp to the bracket for the MAP sensor.
Connect the VSV connector for the vapor pressure sensor.
Connect the 2 ground strap connectors to the RH fender
apron.
Connect the 2 ground strap connectors to the LH fender
apron.
Install the engine wire protector clamp to the battery
bracket.
Install the engine wire to the clamp on the fuel filter.
Connect the ground cable to the transaxle.
Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the intake
manifold.
Connect the heater hose to the water outlet.
Connect the heater hose to the water bypass pipe.
Connect the fuel inlet hose to the fuel filter with 2 new gaskets and the union bolt.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
Connect the MAP sensor vacuum hose to the gas filter on
the intake manifold.
33.
(a)
S05251
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
Install the support bracket with the nut.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
(b) Temporarily install 2 new gaskets and the front exhaust
pipe with the 2 bolts and 5 nuts.
(c) Tighten the 3 nuts holding the exhaust manifold to the
front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
(d) Tighten the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
Torque: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
(e) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
(f)
Install the support stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
34. INSTALL RADIATOR (See page CO–23)
35. INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
36. INSTALL BATTERY TRAY AND BATTERY
37. INSTALL AIR CLEANER CASE
Install the air cleaner case with the 3 bolts.
Author:
Date:
1252
EM–81
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
38.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
–
ENGINE UNIT
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP
Connect the air cleaner hose to the throttle body.
Attach the air cleaner cap to the air cleaner case, and
install the 2 clamps.
Tighten the air cleaner hose clamp.
Connect the PCV hose to the cylinder head cover.
Connect the EVAP hose to the throttle body.
Connect the EVAP hose to the VSV.
Connect the IAT sensor connector.
Connect the VSV connector for the EVAP.
CONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
INSTALL ENGINE FENDER APRON SEALS
INSTALL HOOD
FILL ENGINE WITH OIL
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT AND OIL LEVELS
Author:
Date:
1253
EM–82
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM08H–03
COMPONENTS
Generator
* Gasket
Wire
Clamp
No.2 Timing Belt
Cover
Timing Belt
No.1 Timing Belt
Cover
Timing Belt Guide
* Gasket
Crankshaft
Pulley
High–Tension Cord
108 (1,100, 80)
Spark Plug
18 (180, 13)
Wire Clamp
Wire Clamp
Wire Clamp
Tension Spring
Camshaft Timing Pulley
54 (550, 40)
No.1 Idler Pulley
42 (425, 31)
No.2 Idler Pulley
42 (425, 31)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
* Replace only if damaged
Crankshaft Timing Pulley
A07366
Author:
Date:
1254
EM–83
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
PCV Hose
CYLINDER BLOCK
19 (190, 14)
Intake Camshaft
44 (450, 33)
Grommet
Camshaft Bearing Cap
Cylinder Head
Cover
x 10
Gasket
Camshaft Oil Seal
Exhaust Camshaft
See page EM–53
1st 49 (500, 36)
2nd Turn 90°
Cylinder Head Assembly
No.3 Timing Belt Cover
VSV for EGR
Cylinder Head Gasket
IAC Valve Water Bypass Hose
Water Bypass Hose
Knock Sensor 1 Connector
Wire Clamp
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Connector
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A07354
Author:
Date:
1255
EM–84
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
w/ Oil Cooler
Water Pump, Water Bypass Pipe
and Oil Cooler Assembly
Water Pump and Water
Bypass Pipe Assembly
(w/o Oil Cooler)
Union Bolt
78.5 (800, 58)
O–Ring
Oil Filter
Generator Drive Belt Adjusting Bar
Knock Sensor 1
Oil Dipstick
PS Pump
Bracket
O–Ring
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Oil Pump
x 10
Gasket
Gasket
8.8 (90, 78 in.·lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
Crankshaft
Front Oil
Seal
Oil Strainer
x 17
Oil Pan
Gasket
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
Drain Plug
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A07367
Author:
Date:
1256
EM–85
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
No.1 Piston Ring
No.2 Piston Ring
Oil Ring (Expander)
Oil Ring (Side Rail)
Piston
Snap Ring
Snap Ring
Piston Pin
Connecting Rod Bushing
Connecting Rod
Connecting Rod Bearing
Rear Oil Seal
Retainer
Connecting Rod Cap
Crankshaft
Rear Oil
Seal
See page EM–107
1st 25 (250, 18)
2nd Turn 90°
x6
Cylinder Block
Gasket
Upper Crankshaft
Thrust Washer
Upper Main Bearing
Crankshaft
Lower Main Bearing
Lower Crankshaft
Thrust Washer
Main Bearing Cap
59 (600, 43)
Adjusting Spacer
Engine Balancer
x6
49 (500, 36)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A07353
Author:
Date:
1257
EM–86
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM0YW–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL ENGINE TO ENGINE STAND FOR DISASSEMBLY
2.
REMOVE TIMING BELT AND PULLEYS
(See page EM–17)
3.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and No.3 timing belt cover.
(b) Remove the cylinder head cover.
(1) Disconnect the PCV hose from the intake manifold.
(2) Remove the 4 nuts, 4 grommets, head cover and
gasket.
(c) Remove the camshafts. (See page EM–33)
(d) Disconnect the knock sensor 1 connector.
(e) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
(f)
Disconnect the wire clamp from the generator drive belt
adjusting bar.
(g) Disconnect the IAC valve water bypass hose from the water bypass pipe.
(h) Disconnect the water bypass hose (from the water bypass pipe) from the water outlet.
(i)
Remove the bolt holding the VSV for EGR to the intake
manifold.
(j)
Remove the 2 bolts holding the water bypass pipe to the
cylinder head.
(k) Remove the cylinder head assembly.
(See page EM–33)
4.
REMOVE OIL DIPSTICK
5.
REMOVE OIL PAN AND OIL PUMP
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector
from the generator drive belt adjusting bar.
(b) Remove the oil pan and oil pump. (See page LU–7)
6.
REMOVE PS PUMP BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and pump bracket.
7.
REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR 1 (See page SF–57)
8.
REMOVE OIL FILTER (See page LU–2)
9.
1
3
(a)
2
(b)
(c)
S06011
REMOVE WATER PUMP, WATER BYPASS PIPE AND
OIL COOLER (w/ OIL COOLER) ASSEMBLY
w/ Oil Cooler:
Remove the nut and union bolt, and disconnect the oil
cooler. Remove the O–ring.
Remove the bolt and generator drive belt adjusting bar.
Remove the 3 bolts in the sequence shown, remove the
water pump, water bypass pipe, oil cooler (w/ oil cooler)
assembly and O–ring.
Author:
Date:
1258
EM–87
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
10. REMOVE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
Remove the 6 bolts, retainer and gasket.
P05527
11.
P00717
A
B
280°
4
210°
B
No.1 Balance
Shaft Gear
Crankshaft
Gear
100°
3
A
2
1
30°
TDC
CHECK THRUST CLEARANCES OF NO.1 AND NO.2
BALANCE SHAFTS OF ENGINE BALANCER
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while moving the balance shaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.060 – 0.110 mm (0.0024 – 0.0043 in.)
Maximum clearance: 0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the balance
shaft housings and bearings. If necessary, replace the balance
shafts.
12. CHECK AND ADJUST BACKLASH OF CRANKSHAFT
GEAR AND NO.1 BALANCE SHAFT GEAR
NOTICE:
Backlash between the crankshaft gear and No.1 balance
shaft gear varies with the rotation of the balance shaft and
the deviation of the crankshaft gear. Accordingly, it is necessary to measure the backlash at the 4 points shown in
the illustration on the left.
Z19418
(a)
(b)
Turn the crankshaft 2 or 3 times to settle the crankshaft
gear and No.1 balance shaft gear.
When the No.1 piston is at TDC, check that the punch
marks shown in the illustration of the balance shafts are
aligned with the grooves of the No.2 housing.
P01477
No.1 Balance Shaft
(c)
Check that punch marks A and B are at the positions on
the No.1 balance shaft indicated in the illustration.
Mark A
Mark B
Z19410
Author:
Date:
1259
EM–88
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
No.1 Balance
Shaft
Mark A
CYLINDER BLOCK
(d)
First turn the crankshaft clockwise, and align the groove
of the No.2 balance shaft housing with punch mark A of
the No.1 balance shaft.
(e)
Set SST and a dial indicator as shown in the illustration.
SST 09224–74010
No.2 Housing
Mark B
–
Z19412
Measuring Point
for Dial Indicator
HINT:
Make sure that the needle of the dial indicator is perpendicular
to the SST and that it is placed in the middle of the 3rd indention.
SST
S05942
(f)
Lightly turn the No.1 balance shaft by hand and measure
the backlash.
HINT:
S05943
Mark B
No.2 Housing
No.1 Balance
Shaft
Turn the No.1 balance shaft 4 or 5 times to provide a
steady backlash reading.
To prevent excessive backlash due to thrust clearance,
measure the backlash while pressing on the rear of the
No.1 balance shaft.
Standard backlash (at punch mark A):
0.005 – 0.040 mm (0.0002 – 0.0016 in.)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the No.1 balance shaft strongly.
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Mark A
Remove the dial indicator and SST.
Turn the crankshaft clockwise to align the groove of the
No.2 housing with punch mark B.
Set the dial indicator. (See step (e))
Measure the backlash. (See step (f))
Standard backlash (at punch mark B):
0.005 – 0.060 mm (0.0002 – 0.0024 in.)
Remove the dial indicator.
Z19414
Author:
Date:
1260
EM–89
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
No.1 Balance
Shaft
Mark A
No.2 Housing
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
Mark B
CYLINDER BLOCK
Turn the crankshaft clockwise again to align the groove
of the No.2 housing with punch mark A.
Set the dial indicator. (See step (e))
Measure the backlash. (See step (f))
Standard backlash (at punch mark A):
0.005 – 0.040 mm (0.0002 – 0.0016 in.)
Remove the dial indicator.
Z19412
(p)
Mark B
No.2 Housing
–
No.1 Balance
Shaft
Mark A
Z19414
Turn the crankshaft clockwise again to align the groove
of the No.2 housing with punch mark B.
(q) Set the dial indicator. (See step (e))
(r)
Measure the backlash. (See step (f))
Standard backlash (at punch mark B):
0.005 – 0.060 mm (0.0002 – 0.0024 in.)
(s) Remove the dial indicator.
If even one of the 4 points measured above exceeds the backlash specification, adjust the backlash with new spacers.
NOTICE:
Use the same size spacers for both the left and right sides.
HINT:
Varying the spacer thickness by 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
change the backlash by about 0.014 mm (0.0006 in.).
If the backlash is greater than permitted maximum, select
a thinner shim.
If the backlash is less than the specification, select a thicker shim.
Author:
Date:
1261
EM–90
Adjusting Spacer Selection Chart (Off–Vehicle)
Measured
backlash
Installed spacer
No.
mm (in.)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Author:
Date:
Standard backlash (at punch mark A):
0.005 – 0.40 mm (0.0002 – 0.0016 in.)
EXAMPLE: The No.26 spacers are installed, and the measured backlash is
0.120 mm (0.0047 in.). Replace the No. 26 spacers with new No.11 spacers.
New spacer thickness
No.
A01917
1262
01
03
05
07
09
Thickness
1.74 (0.0685)
1.76 (0.0693)
1.78 (0.0701)
1.80 (0.0709)
1.82 (0.0717)
No.
11
13
15
17
19
Thickness
1.84 (0.0724)
1.86 (0.0732)
1.88 (0.0740)
1.90 (0.0748)
1.92 (0.0756)
No.
21
23
25
27
29
mm (in.)
Thickness
1.94 (0.0764)
1.96 (0.0772)
1.98 (0.0780)
2.00 (0.0787)
2.02 (0.0975)
No.
Thickness
31
33
2.04 (0.0803)
2.06 (0.0811)
2.08 (0.0819)
2.10 (0.0827)
2.12 (0.0835)
35
37
39
EM–91
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
13.
(a)
4
6
2
(b)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
REMOVE ENGINE BALANCER
Uniformly loosen and remove the 6 bolts in several
passes, in the sequence shown.
Remove the engine balancer and spacers.
1
5
3
S03789
14. CHECK CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.160 – 0.312 mm (0.0063 – 0.0123 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
connecting rod assembly. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
N00991
15.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CONNECTING ROD CAPS AND CHECK OIL
CLEARANCE
Check the matchmarks on the connecting rod and cap to
ensure correct reassembly.
Remove the 2 connecting rod cap nuts.
P03166
(c)
Using a plastic–faced hammer, lightly tap the connecting
rod bolts and lift off the connecting rod cap.
HINT:
Keep the lower bearing inserted with the connecting rod cap.
N00924
(d)
Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of hose
to protect the crankshaft from damage.
(e) Clean the crank pin and bearing.
(f)
Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and scratches.
If the crank pin or bearing is damaged, replace the bearings. If
necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
N00993
Author:
Date:
1263
EM–92
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(g)
Plastigage
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Lay a strip of Plastigage across the crank pin.
N00999
(h) Install the connecting rod cap.(See page EM–107)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(i)
Remove the connecting rod cap.
(See steps (b) and (c))
Z19381
(j)
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
STD
0.024 – 0.055 mm (0.0009 – 0.0022 in.)
U/S 0.25
0.023 – 0.069 mm (0.0009 – 0.0027 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
N00920
Mark
1, 2 or 3
Mark
1, 2 or 3
HINT:
If using a standard bearing, replace it with one having the same
number marked on the connecting rod cap. There are 3 sizes
of standard bearings, marked ”1”, ”2” and ”3” accordingly.
Reference
Standard sized bearing center wall thickness:
N00932
(k)
Mark ”1”
1.484 – 1.488 mm (0.0584 – 0.0586 in.)
Mark ”2”
1.488 – 1.492 mm (0.0586 – 0.0587 in.)
Mark ”3”
1.492 – 1.496 mm (0.0587 – 0.0589 in.)
Completely remove the Plastigage.
Author:
Date:
1264
EM–93
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
16.
(a)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
REMOVE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD ASSEMBLIES
Using a ridge reamer, remove all the carbon from the top
of the cylinder.
S05989
(b)
(c)
Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of hose
to protect the crankshaft from damage.
Push the piston, connecting rod assembly and upper
bearing through the top of the cylinder block.
HINT:
Keep the bearings, connecting rod and cap together.
Arrange the piston and connecting rod assemblies in the
correct order.
N00993
P00598
6
8
10
4
2
1
17. CHECK CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while prying
the crankshaft back and forth with a screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.020 – 0.220 mm (0.0008 – 0.0087 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
thrust washer as a set.
Thrust washer thickness:
2.440 – 2.490 mm (0.0961 – 0.0980 in.)
18. REMOVE MAIN BEARING CAPS AND CHECK OIL
CLEARANCE
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 main bearing cap
bolts in several passes, in the sequence shown.
5
9
7
3
P00105
(b)
Using 2 screwdrivers, pry out the main bearing cap, and
remove the 5 main bearing caps, 5 lower bearings and 2
lower thrust washers (No.3 main bearing cap only).
HINT:
(c)
Keep the lower bearing and main bearing cap together.
Arrange the main bearing caps and lower thrust washers
in the correct order.
Lift out the crankshaft.
S06014
Author:
Date:
1265
EM–94
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
HINT:
Keep the upper bearing and upper thrust washers together with
the cylinder block.
(d) Clean each main journal and bearing.
(e) Check each main journal and bearing for pitting and
scratches.
If the journal or bearing is damaged, replace the bearings. If
necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
(f)
(g)
Plastigage
Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal.
N01000
1
3
9
5
10
7
2
8
(h) Install the main bearing caps. (See page EM–107)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(i)
Remove the main bearing caps.
(See steps (a) and (b))
6
4
P00104
(j)
N00988
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard clearance:
No.3
STD
U/S 0.25
0.025 – 0.044 mm (0.0010 – 0.0017 in.)
0.027 – 0.067 mm (0.0011 – 0.0026 in.)
Others
STD
U/S 0.25
0.015 – 0.034 mm (0.0006 – 0.0013 in.)
0.019 – 0.059 mm (0.0007 – 0.0023 in.)
Maximum clearance: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
HINT:
If replacing the cylinder block subassembly, the bearing standard clearance will be:
No.3
0.027 – 0.054 mm (0.0001 – 0.0021 in.)
Others
0.017 – 0.044 mm (0.0007 – 0.0017 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
Author:
Date:
1266
EM–95
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
No.1 No.2 No.3 No.4 No.5
No.5
No.4
No.3
No.2
No.1
Mark
1, 2 or 3
Mark
0, 1 or 2
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
HINT:
If using a standard bearing, replace it with one having the same
number. If the number of the bearing cannot be determined, select the correct bearing by adding together the numbers imprinted on the cylinder block and crankshaft, then selecting the
bearing with the same number as the total. There are 5 sizes
of standard bearings, marked ”1”, ”2”, ”3”, ”4” and ”5” accordingly.
Number marked
Cylinder block
Mark
1, 2, 3, 4, or 5
1
2
3
Crankshaft
0
1
2
0
1
2
0
1
2
Use bearing
1
2
3
2
3
4
3
4
5
EXAMPLE: Cylinder block ”2” + Crankshaft ”1”
= Total number 3 (Use bearing ”3”)
Reference
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter:
Z00060
Mark ”1”
59.020 – 59.026 mm (2.3236 – 2.3239 in.)
Mark ”2”
59.026 – 59.032 mm (2.3239 – 2.3241 in.)
Mark ”3”
59.032 – 59.038 mm (2.3241 – 2.3243 in.)
Crankshaft main journal diameter:
Mark ”0”
54.998 – 55.003 mm (2.1653 – 2.1655 in.)
Mark ”1”
54.993 – 54.998 mm (2.1651 – 2.1653 in.)
Mark ”2”
54.988 – 54.993 mm (2.1649 – 2.1651 in.)
Standard sized bearing center wall thickness:
No.3
Mark ”1”
1.992 – 1.995 mm (0.0784 – 0.0785 in.)
Mark ”2”
1.995 – 1.998 mm (0.0785 – 0.0787 in.)
Mark ”3”
1.998 – 2.001 mm (0.0787 – 0.0788 in.)
Mark ”4”
2.001 – 2.004 mm (0.0788 – 0.0789 in.)
Mark ”5”
2.004 – 2.007 mm (0.0789 – 0.0790 in.)
Others
(k)
19.
(a)
(b)
Mark ”1”
1.997 – 2.000 mm (0.0786 – 0.0787 in.)
Mark ”2”
2.000 – 2.003 mm (0.0787 – 0.0789 in.)
Mark ”3”
2.003 – 2.006 mm (0.0789 – 0.0790 in.)
Mark ”4”
2.006 – 2.009 mm (0.0790 – 0.0791 in.)
Mark ”5”
2.009 – 2.012 mm (0.0791 – 0.0792 in.)
Complately remove the Plastigage.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT
Lift out the crankshaft.
Remove the 5 upper bearings and 2 upper thrust washers
from the cylinder block.
HINT:
Arrange the main bearing caps, bearings and thrust washers in
the correct order.
Author:
Date:
1267
EM–96
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
20. CHECK FIT BETWEEN PISTON AND PISTON PIN
Try to move the piston back and forth on the piston pin.
If any movement is felt, replace the piston and pin as a set.
A06590
21.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON RINGS
Using a piston ring expander, remove the No.1 and No.2
piston rings.
Remove the 2 side rails and oil ring expander by hand.
(b)
HINT:
Arrange the piston rings in correct order only.
A06589
22.
(a)
DISCONNECT CONNECTING ROD FROM PISTON
Using a small screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
(b)
Gradually heat the piston to 80 – 90°C (176 – 194°F).
(c)
Using a plastic–faced hammer and brass bar, lightly tap
out the piston pin and remove the connecting rod.
A06587
A01774
HINT:
The piston and pin are a matched set.
Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods and
bearings in the correct order.
A01775
Author:
Date:
1268
EM–97
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM08J–03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
CLEAN CYLINDER BLOCK
Remove the gasket material.
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the top surface of the cylinder block.
Clean the cylinder block.
Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the cylinder block.
S05970
2.
(a)
INSPECT CYLINDER BLOCK
Inspect for flatness.
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surfaces contacting the cylinder head gasket for
warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cylinder block.
Z19127
(b) Visually check the cylinder for vertical scratches.
If deep scratches are present, rebore all the 4 cylinders and replace all the 4 pistons. (See page EM–104) If necessary, replace the cylinder block.
S05987
(c) Inspect the cylinder bore diameter.
HINT:
There are 3 sizes of the standard cylinder bore diameter,
marked ”1”, ”2” and ”3” accordingly. The mark is stamped on the
top of the cylinder block.
Mark 1, 2 or 3
No.1 No.2 No.3 No.4
S05569
Author:
Date:
1269
EM–98
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore diameter at positions A, B and C in the thrust and axial directions.
Standard diameter:
Mark ”1”
87.000 – 87.010 mm (3.4252 – 3.4256 in.)
Mark ”2”
87.010 – 87.020 mm (3.4256 – 3.4262 in.)
Mark ”3”
87.020 – 87.030 mm (3.4260 – 3.4264 in.)
Maximum diameter:
Front
2
1
Thrust
1 Direction
A
Axial
2
Direction
10 mm
(0.39 in.)
STD
87.23 mm (3.4342 in.)
O/S 0.50
87.73 mm (3.4350 in.)
If the diameter is greater than maximum, rebore all the 4 cylinders and replace all the 4 pistons. (See page EM–104) If necessary, replace the cylinder block.
B
C
10 mm
(0.39 in.)
Z19307
Ridge Reamer
(d) Remove the cylinder ridge.
If the wear is less than 0.2 mm (0.008 in.), using a ridge reamer,
grind the top of the cylinder.
S05989
3.
(a)
CLEAN PISTON
Using a gasket scraper, remove the carbon from the piston top.
(b)
Using a groove cleaning tool or broken ring, clean the piston ring grooves.
A06591
A06592
Author:
Date:
1270
EM–99
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(c) Using solvent and a brush, thoroughly clean the piston.
NOTICE:
Do not use a wire brush.
A06593
4.
INSPECT PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
(a) Inspect the piston oil clearance.
HINT:
There are 3 sizes of the standard piston diameter, marked ”1”,
”2” and ”3” accordingly. The mark is stamped on the piston top.
Mark 1, 2 or 3
Front
Mark
(Cavity)
A07350
(1)
Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at
right angles to the piston pin center line, 20.5 mm
(0.807 in.) from the piston head.
Piston diameter:
STD
20.5 mm
A07352
Mark ”1”
Mark ”2”
Mark ”3”
86.815 – 86.825 mm (3.4179 – 3.4183 in.)
86.825 – 86.835 mm (3.4183 – 3.4186 in.)
86.835 – 86.845 mm (3.4186 – 3.4190 in.)
O/S 0.50
87.315 – 87.345 mm (3.4375 – 3.4387 in.)
(2)
Measure the cylinder bore diameter in the thrust
directions. (See step 2)
(3) Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the
cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.175 – 0.195 mm (0.0068 – 0.0076 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.215 mm (0.0085 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace all the 4
pistons and rebore all the 4 cylinders. (See page EM–104) If
necessary, replace the cylinder block.
Author:
Date:
1271
EM–100
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
HINT:
Use new cylinder block:
Use a piston with the same number mark as the cylinder bore
diameter marked on the cylinder block.
Mark 1, 2 or 3
No.1 No.2 No.3 No.4
Mark 1, 2 or 3
S05569
A07350
A07397
(b)
Inspect the piston ring groove clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
new piston ring and the wall of the ring groove.
Ring groove clearance (No.1, No.2):
0.030 – 0.070 mm (0.0012 – 0.0028 in.)
If the clearance is not as specified, replace the piston.
A07348
(c)
Inspect the piston ring end gap.
(1) Insert the piston ring into the cylinder bore.
(2) Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond
the bottom of the ring travel, 110 mm (4.33 in.) from
the top of the cylinder block.
110 mm
A01916
(3) Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard end gap:
No.1
0.270 – 0.490 mm (0.0106 – 0.0192 in.)
No.2
0.450 – 0.670 mm (0.0177 – 0.0263 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
0.100 – 0.470 mm (0.0039 – 0.0185 in.)
Maximum end gap:
EM7639
No.1
1.09 mm (0.0429 in.)
No.2
1.27 mm (0.0499 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
1.07 mm (0.0421 in.)
Author:
Date:
1272
EM–101
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
If the end gap is greater than maximum, replace the piston ring.
If the end gap is greater than maximum, even with a new piston
ring, rebore all the 4 cylinders (see page EM–104) or replace
the cylinder block.
(d)
Inspect the piston pin fit.
At 60°C (140°F), you should be able to push the piston
pin into the piston pin hole with your thumb.
A06594
(e)
Using a rod aligner and feeler gauge, check the connecting rod alignment.
(1) Check for bend.
Maximum bend:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If bend is greater than maximum, replace the connecting rod assembly.
Z00064
(2) Check for twist
Maximum twist:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If twist is greater than maximum, replace the connecting rod assembly.
Z00065
(f)
Inspect the piston pin oil clearance.
(1) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter
of the connecting rod bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
22.005 – 22.017 mm (0.8663 – 0.8668 in.)
EM7538
Author:
Date:
1273
EM–102
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(2)
EM0227
Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 – 22.009 mm (0.8660 – 0.8665 in.)
(3) Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from
the bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 – 0.011 mm (0.0002 – 0.0004 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the bushing. (See page EM–104) If necessary, replace the piston and
piston pin as a set.
(g)
Inspect the connecting rod bolts.
(1) Install the cap nut to the connecting rod bolt. Check
that the cap nut can be turned easily by hand to the
end of the thread.
P13428
(2)
If the cap nut cannot be turned easily, measure the
outside diameter of the connecting rod bolt with a
vernier caliper.
Standard diameter:
7.860 – 8.000 mm (0.3094 – 0.3150 in.)
Minimum diameter: 7.60 mm (0.2992 in.)
15 mm
(0.59 in.)
A02826
HINT:
If the location of this area cannot be judged by visual inspection,
measure the outer diameter at the location shown in the illustration.
If the outside diameter is less than minimum, replace the connecting rod bolt and nut as a set.
Author:
Date:
1274
EM–103
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
5.
(a)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT
Inspect for circle runout.
(1) Place the crankshaft on V–blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at
the center journal.
Maximum circle runout: 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, replace the crankshaft.
P00118
(b)
Inspect the main journals and crank pins.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each
main journal and crank pin.
Main journal diameter:
STD
54.988 – 55.003 mm (2.1653 – 2.1655 in.)
U/S 0.25
54.745 – 54.755 mm (2.1553 – 2.1557 in.)
Crank pin diameter:
EM3553
STD
51.985 – 52.000 mm (2.0466 – 2.0472 in.)
U/S 0.25
51.745 – 51.755 mm (2.0372 – 2.0376 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance. (See
page EM–86) If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
(2) Check each main journal and crank pin for taper
and out–of–round as shown.
Maximum taper and out–of–round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and out–of–round is greater than maximum, replace
the crankshaft.
6.
IF NECESSARY, GRIND AND HONE MAIN JOURNALS
AND/OR CRANK PINS
Grind and hone the main journals and/or crank pins to the finished undersized diameter. (See procedure in step 5) Install
new main journal and/or crankshaft pin undersized bearings.
Author:
Date:
1275
EM–104
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM08K–03
REPLACEMENT
SST
1.
(a)
REPLACE CONNECTING ROD BUSHINGS
Using SST and a press, press out the bushing.
SST 09222–30010
(b)
Align the oil holes of a new bushing and the connecting
rod.
Using SST and a press, press in the bushing.
SST 09222–30010
EM1321
(c)
Oil Hole
EM7329
(d)
Using a pin hole grinder, hone the bushing to obtain the
standard specified clearance (See page EM–97) between the bushing and piston pin.
(e)
Check the piston pin fit at normal room temperature. Coat
the piston pin with engine oil, and push it into the connecting rod with your thumb.
REPLACE OVERSIZED (O/S) PISTONS FOR CYLINDER BORING
P01038
2.
HINT:
EM1322
(a)
Bore all the 4 cylinders for the O/S piston outside diameter.
Replace all the piston rings with ones to match the O/S
pistons.
Keep 4 new O/S pistons.
O/S 0.50 piston diameter:
87.350 – 87.380 mm (3.4390 – 3.4402 in.)
Author:
Date:
1276
EM–105
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(b)
20.5 mm
A07352
SST
S01546
Cut Position
Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at right
angles to the piston pin center line, 20.5 mm (0.807 in.)
from the piston head.
(c) Calculate the amount of each cylinder is to be rebored as
follows:
Size to be rebored = P + C – H
P = Piston diameter
C = Piston oil clearance
0.175 – 0.195 mm (0.0068 – 0.0076 in.)
H = Allowance for honing
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.) or less
(d) Bore and hone the cylinders to calculated dimensions.
Maximum honing: 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
NOTICE:
Excess honing will destroy the finished roundness.
3.
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
HINT:
There are 2 methods ((a) and (b)) to replace the oil seal.
(a) If the oil pump is removed from the cylinder block:
(1) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the oil
seal.
(2) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09226–10010
(3) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
(b) If the oil pump is installed to the cylinder block:
(1) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(2) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape the screwdriver tip.
Pry
S05573
(3)
(4)
Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09226–10010
SST
S05572
Author:
Date:
1277
EM–106
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
4.
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT REAR OIL SEAL
HINT:
there are 2 methods ((a) and (b)) to replace the oil seal.
(a) If the rear oil seal retainer is removed from the cylinder
block:
(1) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the oil
seal.
EM7362
(2)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer
edge.
SST 09223–15030, 09950–70010 (09951–07100)
(3) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
SST
P19502
(b)
If rear oil seal retainer is installed to cylinder block:
(1) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(2) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape the screwdriver tip.
Cut position
S06005
(3)
(4)
Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223–15030, 09950–70010 (09951–07100)
SST
S06004
Author:
Date:
1278
EM–107
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM08L–03
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all sliding and rotating surfaces.
Replace all gaskets, O–rings and oil seals with new parts.
1.
(a)
ASSEMBLE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on one
side of the piston pin hole.
(b)
Gradually heat the piston to 80 – 90°C (176 – 194°F).
(c)
(d)
Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
Align the front marks of the piston and connecting rod,
and push in the piston pin with your thumb.
(e)
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on the
other side of the piston pin hole.
A06586
A01776
Front Mark
(Cavity)
Front Mark
(Protrusion)
A07349
A06587
Author:
Date:
1279
EM–108
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
2.
(a)
(b)
Code Mark
No.1
No.2
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
INSTALL PISTON RINGS
Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
Using a piston ring expander, install the No.2 and No.1
piston rings with the code mark facing upward.
Code mark:
No.1
1N or T
No.2
2N or 2T
Code Mark
A06588
Upper Side Rail
Expander
No.2
Compression
Ring
No.1
Compression
Ring
(c)
Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as
shown.
NOTICE:
Do not align the ring ends.
Front
Mark
(Cavity)
Lower Side Rail
P
A07351
3.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL BEARINGS
Align the bearing claw with the groove of the connecting
rod or connecting cap.
Install the bearings in the connecting rod and connecting
rod cap.
P00797
Others
No.3
22.9 mm
19.2 mm
P05533
4.
INSTALL MAIN BEARINGS
HINT:
Main bearings come in widths of 19.2 mm (0.756 in.) and
22.9 mm (0.902 in.). Install the 22.9 mm (0.902 in.) bearings in the No.3 cylinder block journal position with the
main bearing cap. Install the 19.2 mm (0.756 in.) bearings
in the other positions.
Upper bearings have an oil groove and oil holes; lower
bearings do not.
(a)
Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the cylinder
block, and push in the 5 upper bearings.
P05353
Author:
Date:
1280
EM–109
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(b)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the main
bearing cap, and push in the 5 lower bearings.
HINT:
A number is marked on each main bearing cap to indicate the
installation position.
Mark
1, 2, 3, 4, or 5
P03177
5.
INSTALL UPPER THRUST WASHERS
Install the 2 thrust washers under the No.3 journal position of
the cylinder block with the oil grooves facing outward.
6.
PLACE CRANKSHAFT ON CYLINDER BLOCK
P05354
7.
(a)
INSTALL MAIN BEARING CAPS AND LOWER
THRUST WASHERS
Install the 2 thrust washers on the No.3 bearing cap with
the grooves facing outward.
P03173
(b) Install the 5 main bearing caps in their proper locations.
HINT:
Each bearing cap has a number and front mark.
S06012
(c)
7
1
3
9
5
(d)
10
2
6
(e)
8.
4
8
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the main bearing cap bolts.
Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bolts of the main bearing cap in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 59 N·m (600 kgf·cm, 43 ft·lbf)
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
CHECK CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page EM–86)
P00104
Author:
Date:
1281
EM–110
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
9.
(a)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
INSTALL PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD ASSEMBLES
Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of hose
to protect the crankshaft from damage.
EM2082
Front Mark
(Cavity)
(b)
Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly numbered piston and connecting rod assemblies into each
cylinder with the front mark of the piston facing forward.
10.
PLACE CONNECTING ROD CAP ON CONNECTING
ROD
Match the numbered connecting rod cap with the connecting rod.
Install the connecting rod cap with the front mark facing
forward.
INSTALL CONNECTING ROD CAP NUTS
Push
Front
A06614
Front Mark
(Protrusion)
(a)
(b)
11.
HINT:
N01001
The cap nuts are tightened in 2 progressive steps (steps
(b) and (d)).
If any one of the connecting rod bolts is broken or deformed, replace it.
(a)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the nuts of the connecting rod cap.
(b) Install and alternately tighten the 2 cap nuts in several
passes.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
If any one of the cap nuts does not meet the torque specification, replace the connecting rod bolt and cap nut as a set.
Z19381
Author:
Date:
1282
EM–111
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Painted Mark
90°
Front
90°
(f)
12.
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Mark the front of the cap nut with the paint.
Retighten the cap nuts 90° as shown.
Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to the
front.
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
CHECK CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page EM–86)
S02826
13.
(a)
INSTALL ENGINE BALANCER
Turn the crankshaft, and set the No.1 cylinder TDC as
shown in the illustration.
(b)
Set the balance shafts so that the punch marks of the balance shafts are aligned with the grooves of the
No.2 housing.
Pulley
Set
Key
Cylinder
Block Top
Surface
S05945
P01478
(c) Wipe clean the installation surface of the spacer.
(d) Place the spacers on the cylinder block.
HINT:
When replacing the crankshaft and/or balance shaft, use the
thickest spacers.
P00716
(e)
(f)
Place the engine balancer on the cylinder block.
Check that punch marks shown in the illustration of the
balance shafts are aligned with the grooves of the No.2
housing.
P00733
Author:
Date:
1283
EM–112
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(g)
3
1
5
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
While pulling the center part of the engine balancer in the
direction of the arrow, uniformly tighten the 6 bolts in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
6
2
4
Pull
S04614
(h)
Recheck that the punch marks of the balance shafts are
aligned with the grooves of the No.2 housing.
14. CHECK AND ADJUST BACKLASH OF CRANKSHAFT
GEAR AND NO.1 BALANCE SHAFT GEAR
(See page EM–86)
15. INSTALL REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
Install a new gasket and the retainer with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
P01477
16.
3
1
2
Z19357
INSTALL WATER PUMP, WATER BYPASS PIPE AND
OIL COOLER (w/ OIL COOLER) ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O–ring to the water pump cover.
(b) Install the water pump, water bypass pipe and oil cooler
(w/ oil cooler) assembly with the 3 bolts. Tighten the bolts
in the sequence shown.
Torque: 8.8 N·m (90 kgf·cm, 78 in.·lbf)
(c) Install the generator drive belt adjusting bar with the bolt.
Torque: 22 N·m (224 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
(d) w/ Oil Cooler:
Install the oil cooler. (See page LU–18)
17. INSTALL OIL FILTER (See page LU–2)
18. INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR 1 (See page SF–57)
19. INSTALL PS PUMP BRACKET
Install the PS pump bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
20. INSTALL OIL PUMP AND OIL PAN
(a) Install the oil pump and oil pan. (See page LU–13)
(b) Install the crankshaft position sensor connector to the
generator drive belt adjusting bar.
21. INSTALL OIL DIPSTICK
22. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the cylinder head assembly. (See page EM–33)
(b) Install the 2 bolts holding the water bypass pipe to the cylinder head.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(c) Install the VSV for EGR to the cylinder head with the bolt.
(d) Connect the knock sensor 1 connector.
(e) Connect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Author:
Date:
1284
EM–113
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
23.
24.
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Install the wire clamp to the generator drive belt adjusting
bar.
Connect the IAC valve water bypass hose to the water bypass pipe.
Connect the water bypass hose (from the water bypass
pipe) to the water outlet.
Install the camshafts. (See page EM–53)
Install the cylinder head cover.
(1) Install the cylinder head cover. (See page EM–53)
(2) Connect the PCV hose to the intake manifold.
Install the No.3 timing belt cover with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
INSTALL TIMING BELT AND PULLEYS
(See page EM–23)
DISCONNECT ENGINE FROM ENGINE STAND
Author:
Date:
1285
EM–114
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
–
EXHAUST SYSTEM
EXHAUST SYSTEM
EM08M–03
COMPONENTS
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
HINT:
Before installing oxygen sensor, twist
sensor wire counterclockwise 3 and 1/2
turns.
After installing oxygen sensor, check that
sensor wire is not twisted. If it is twisted,
remove oxygen sensor and reinstall it.
Heat Insulator
Ring
Bracket
Tailpipe
33 (330, 24)
Ring
Gasket
Heat Insulator
56 (570, 41)
Heat Insulator
Center Exhaust Pipe
56 (570, 41)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
44 (450, 32)
Bracket
Heat Insulator
19 (195, 14)
Gasket
Gasket
Bracket
TWC (Except California)
Rear TWC (California)
62 (630, 46)
Front Exhaust Pipe
Bracket
Stay
33 (330, 24)
33 (330, 24)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A07369
Author:
Date:
1286
EM–1
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CO/HC
CO/HC
EM04I–04
INSPECTION
CO/HC Meter
HINT:
This check is used only to determine whether or not the idle CO/
HC complies with regulations.
1.
INITIAL CONDITIONS
(a) Engine at normal operating temperature
(b) Air cleaner installed
(c) All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected
(d) All accessories switched OFF
(e) All vacuum lines properly connected
HINT:
All vacuum hoses for EGR systems, etc. should be properly
connected.
(f)
SFI system wiring connectors fully plugged
(g) Ignition timing check correctly
(h) Transmission in neutral position
(i)
Tachometer and CO/HC meter calibrated by hand
2.
START ENGINE
3.
RACE ENGINE AT 2,500 RPM FOR APPROX. 180
SECONDS
4.
INSERT CO/HC METER TESTING PROBE AT LEAST
40 cm (1.3 ft) INTO TAILPIPE DURING IDLING
5.
IMMEDIATELY CHECK CO/HC CONCENTRATION
AT IDLE AND/OR 2,500 RPM
HINT:
When doing the 2 mode (idle and 2,500 rpm) test, these measurement order prescribed by the applicable local regulations.
S04994
Author:
Date:
1287
EM–2
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CO/HC
If the CO/HC concentration dose not comply with regulations,
troubleshoot in the order given below.
See the table below for possible causes, then inspect and correct the applicable causes if necessary.
CO
HC
Problems
Causes
Normal
High
Rough idle
1. Faulty ignitions:
Incorrect timing
Fouled, shorted or improperly gapped plugs
O
Open
en or crossed high–tension cords
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3 Leaky EGR valve
4.Leaky intake and exhaust valves
5.Leaky cylinder
Low
High
Rough idle
(Filtrating HC reading)
1. Vacuum leaks:
PCV hose
EGR valve
Intake manifold
Air intake chamber
Throttle body
IAC valve
Brake booster line
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
High
High
Rough idle
(Black smoke from exhaust)
1. Restricted air filter
2. Faulty SFI system
Faulty pressure regulator
Defective ECT sensor
Faulty ECM
Faulty injectors
Faulty throttle position sensor
Faulty MAF meter
Author:
Date:
1288
EM–3
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
COMPRESSION
COMPRESSION
EM04J–03
INSPECTION
HINT:
If there is lack of power, excessive oil consumption or poor fuel
economy, measure the compression pressure.
1.
WARM UP AND STOP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2.
REMOVE IGNITION COILS AND HIGH–TENSION
CORDS (See page IG–7)
3.
REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs.
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Compression Gauge
P19471
CHECK CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE
Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug hole.
Fully open the throttle.
While cranking the engine, measure the compression
pressure.
HINT:
Always use a fully charged battery to obtain engine speed of
250 rpm or more.
(d) Repeat steps (a) through (c) for each cylinder.
NOTICE:
This measurement must be done in as short a time as possible.
Compression pressure:
1,500 kPa (15.3 kgf/cm2, 218 psi)
Minimum pressure: 1,000 kPa (10.2 kgf/cm2, 145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 15 psi) or less
(e) If the cylinder compression in 1 or more cylinders is low,
pour a small amount of engine oil into the cylinder through
the spark plug hole and repeat steps (a) through (c) for
cylinders with low compression.
If adding oil helps the compression, it is likely that
the piston rings and/or cylinder bore are worn or
damaged.
If pressure stays low, a valve may be sticking or
seating is improper, or there may be leakage past
the gasket.
5.
REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
6.
INSTALL IGNITION COILS AND HIGH–TENSION
CORDS (See page IG–8)
Author:
Date:
1289
EM–4
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
VALVE CLEARANCE
VALVE CLEARANCE
EM04K–04
INSPECTION
HINT:
Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when the engine is cold.
1.
REMOVE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
3.
REMOVE V–BANK COVER
(a) Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 nuts.
(b) Disconnect the 2 clips, and remove the cover.
4.
REMOVE HIGH–TENSION CODE SET
(See page IG–7)
5.
REMOVE AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(See page EM–32)
6.
REMOVE IGNITION COILS
7.
DISCONNECT RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER
OUTLET
8.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVERS
(See page EM–32)
9.
(a)
SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with the
timing mark ”0” of the No.1 timing belt cover.
(b) Check that the valve lifters on the No.1 (IN and EX) are
loose.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°) and align the mark
as above.
P18805
10.
(a)
3 3
RH EX
RH IN
1 1
Front
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
Check only those valves indicated in the illustration.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
(2) Record out of specification valve clearance measurements. They will be used later to determine the
required replacement adjusting shim.
Valve clearance (Cold):
Intake
0.15 – 0.25 mm (0.006 – 0.010 in.)
Exhaust
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.010 – 0.014 in.)
6 6
LH IN
LH EX
2 2
P13074
Author:
Date:
1290
EM–5
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
5 5
–
VALVE CLEARANCE
(b)
Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check
only the valves indicated in the illustration. Measure the
valve clearance. (See step (a))
(c)
Turn the crankshaft a further 2/3 of a revolution (240°),
and check only the valves indicated in the illustration.
Measure the valve clearance. (See step (a))
11.
(a)
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
Remove the adjusting shim.
(1) Turn the camshaft so that the cam lobe for the valve
to be adjusted faces up.
(2) Turn the valve lifter with a screwdriver so that the
notches are perpendicular to the camshaft.
RH EX
RH IN
2 2
3 3
Front
LH IN
LH EX
4 4
P13072
1 1
RH EX
RH IN
5 5
Front
4 4
LH IN
LH EX
6 6
P13073
Upward
Notch
P12919
Author:
Date:
1291
EM–6
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
VALVE CLEARANCE
(3)
Using SST (A), press down the valve lifter and place
SST (B) between the camshaft and valve lifter. Remove SST (A).
SST 09248–55040 (09248–05410, 09248–05420)
Front of No.1 and No.2 Cylinder
SST (A)
HINT:
SST (B)
Others
Apply SST (B) at a slight angle on the side marked with
”9” or ”7”, at the position shown in the illustration.
When SST (B) is inserted too deeply, it will get pinched by
the shim. To prevent it from being stuck, insert it gently
from the intake side, at a slight angle.
SST (A)
SST (B)
Z09456
SST (B)
Using a small screwdriver and magnetic finger, remove
the adjusting shim.
(b)
Determine the replacement adjusting shim size according
to these Formula or Charts:
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the
removed shim.
(2) Calculate the thickness of a new shim so the valve
clearance comes within the specified value.
T .......... Thickness of used shim
A .......... Measured valve clearance
N .......... Thickness of new shim
Intake
N = T + (A – 0.20 mm (0.008 in.))
Exhaust
N = T + (A – 0.30 mm (0.012 in.))
(3) Select a new shim with a thickness as close as possible to the calculated values.
Magnetic Finger
P12920
EM0494
HINT:
Shims are available in 17 sizes in increments of 0.050 mm
(0.0020 in.), from 2.500 mm (0.0984 in.) to 3.300 mm (0.1299
in.).
Author:
Date:
1292
EM–7
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
SST (A)
(c)
SST (B)
(d)
–
VALVE CLEARANCE
Install a new adjusting shim.
(1) Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter, with
imprinted numbers facing down.
(2) Press down the valve lifter with SST (A), and remove SST (B).
SST 09248–55040 (09248–05410, 09248–05420)
Recheck the valve clearance.
P12979
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
REINSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVERS
(See page EM–57)
CONNECT RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER OUTLET
REINSTALL IGNITION COILS
REINSTALL AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(See page EM–57)
INSTALL HIGH–TENSION CORD SET
(See page IG–8)
INSTALL V–BANK COVER
REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
REINSTALL RH FENDER APRON SEAL
Author:
Date:
1293
EM–8
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Intake)
Installed shim thickness
mm (in.)
Measured clearance
mm (in.)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
Author:
Shim
No.
Thickness
Shim
No.
mm (in.)
Thickness
Date:
V00719
1294
Intake valve clearance (Cold):
0.15 – 0.25 mm (0.006 – 0.010 in.)
EXAMPLE: The 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim is installed, and
the measured clearance is 0.450 mm (0.0177 in.).
Replace the 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim with a new No.12 shim.
HINT: New shims have the thickness in
millimeters imprinted on the face.
VALVE CLEARANCE
New shim thickness
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Exhaust)
Installed shim thickness
mm (in.)
Measured clearance
mm (in.)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
Author:
Shim
No.
Thickness
Shim
No.
mm (in.)
Thickness
VALVE CLEARANCE
New shim thickness
Date:
HINT: New shims have the thickness in
millimeters imprinted on the face.
EM–9
V00720
1295
Exhaust valve clearance (Cold):
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.010 – 0.014 in.)
EXAMPLE: The 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim is installed, and
the measured clearance is 0.450 mm (0.0177 in.).
Replace the 2.800 mm (0.1102 in.) shim with a new No.12 shim.
EM–10
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
IGNITION TIMING
IGNITION TIMING
EM04L–03
INSPECTION
1.
WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
TOYOTA
Hand–Held Tester
S05358
E1
DLC1
SST
2.
CONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR
OBDII SCAN TOOL
(a) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII scan tool
to the DLC3.
(b) Please refer to the TOYOTA hand–held tester or OBDII
scan tool operator’s manual for further details.
3.
CONNECT TIMING LIGHT TO ENGINE
Connect the tester probe of a timing light to the No.1 high–tension cord for No.4 cylinder.
4.
CHECK IDLE SPEED
(a) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
5.
(a)
INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
(b)
Using a timing light, check the ignition timing.
Ignition timing: 8 – 12° BTDC @ idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
TE1
DLC1
S04529
(c)
A06644
Author:
Date:
1296
EM–11
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
6.
–
IGNITION TIMING
FURTHER CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing: 7 – 24° BTDC @ idle
(Transmission in neutral position)
HINT:
The timing mark moves in a range between 7° and 24°.
7.
DISCONNECT TIMING LIGHT FROM ENGINE
8.
DISCONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR
OBDII SCAN TOOL
Author:
Date:
1297
EM–12
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
IDLE SPEED
IDLE SPEED
EM0YN–01
INSPECTION
1.
INITIAL CONDITIONS
(a) Engine at normal operating temperature
(b) Air cleaner installed
(c) All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected
(d) All accessories switched OFF
(e) All vacuum lines properly connected
HINT:
All vacuum hoses for EGR system, etc. should be properly connected.
(f)
SFI system wiring connectors fully plugged
(g) Ignition timing check correctly
(h) Transmission in neutral position
2.
CONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR OBDII SCAN TOOL (See page EM–10)
3.
INSPECT IDLE SPEED
(a) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approx. 90 seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
If the idle speed is not as specified, check the IAC valve and air intake system.
4.
DISCONNECT TOYOTA HAND–HELD TESTER OR OBDII SCAN TOOL
Author:
Date:
1298
EM–13
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
TIMING BELT
EM04N–03
COMPONENTS
RH Fender Apron Seal
64 (650, 47)
32 (320, 23)
Generator Drive Belt
Engine Moving
Control Rod
RH Engine Mounting Stay
64 (650, 47)
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Bracket
PS Pump Drive Belt
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Stay (M/T)
Ground Strap
Engine Coolant Reservoir Hose
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A06654
Author:
Date:
1299
EM–14
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
Timing Belt
Gasket
No.2 Timing Belt Cover
RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Timing Belt Guide
28 (290, 21)
No.2 Generator
Bracket
No.1 Timing Belt Cover
Gasket
Crankshaft
Pulley
Engine Wire
Protector
RH Camshaft Timing Pulley
No.2 Idler Pulley
215 (2,200, 159)
125 (1,300, 94)
*88 (900, 65)
LH Camshaft
Timing Pulley
43 (440, 32)
125 (1,300, 94)
No.1 Idler Pulley
Plate Washer
Dust Boot
34 (350, 25)
Timing Belt Plate
Crankshaft
Timing Pulley
27 (280, 20)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Precoated part
Timing Belt Tensioner
* For use with SST
B06384
Author:
Date:
1300
EM–15
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
EM04O–04
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
P18754
REMOVE RH FRONT WHEEL
REMOVE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
(See page CH–6)
4.
REMOVE PS PUMP DRIVE BELT
Loosen the 2 bolts, and remove the drive belt.
5.
DISCONNECT ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR
HOSE FROM WATER OUTLET
6.
DISCONNECT GROUND STRAP CONNECTORS
7.
REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY, NO.2 RH
ENGINE MOUNTING STAY (M/T), ENGINE MOVING
CONTROL ROD AND NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING
BRACKET (See page EM–71)
8.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NO.2 GENERATOR BRACKET
Loosen the generator pivot bolt.
Remove the nut and bracket.
9.
(a)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
Using SST, remove the pulley bolt.
SST 09213–54015 (91651–60855),
09330–00021
(b)
Using SST, remove the pulley.
SST 09950–50012 (09951–05010, 09952–05010,
09953–05010, 09953–05020, 09954–05020)
P18816
SST
P18817
SST
P18819
Author:
Date:
1301
EM–16
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
10. REMOVE NO.1 TIMING BELT COVER
Remove the 4 bolts and timing belt cover.
11. REMOVE TIMING BELT GUIDE
P18820
12.
(a)
Clamp
Clamp
(b)
REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
Disconnect the engine wire protector clamps from the
No.3 timing belt cover.
Remove the 5 bolts and timing belt cover.
A01800
13. REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 2 bolts, nut and mounting bracket.
P18814
14.
(a)
SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt to the crankshaft.
(b) Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing marks of the
crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump body.
NOTICE:
Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
P18808
(c)
Check that timing marks of the camshaft timing pulleys
and No.3 timing belt cover are aligned.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°).
(d) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
A05052
Author:
Date:
1302
EM–17
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
15.
IF REUSING TIMING BELT, CHECK INSTALLATION
MARKS ON TIMING BELT
Check that there are 3 installation marks and front mark on the
timing belt.
If the installation and front marks have disappeared, before removing the timing belt, place 3 new installation marks on the
timing belt to match the timing marks of the timing pulleys, and
place a new front mark on the timing belt.
A01804
16. REMOVE TIMING BELT TENSIONER
Alternately loosen the 2 bolts, and remove them, the tensioner
and dust boot.
17. REMOVE TIMING BELT
A05053
18.
(a)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
Using SST, remove the bolt and RH timing pulley.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09962–01000,
09963–01000)
LH
(b)
Using SST, remove the LH timing pulley.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–01000)
SST
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft timing pulleys (RH and LH sides).
RH
SST
P12764
P12762
19. REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
A05055
Author:
Date:
1303
EM–18
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
Plate Washer
10 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
–
TIMING BELT
20. REMOVE NO.1 IDLER PULLEY
Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the bolt, idler pulley
and plate washer.
A01802
21.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Remove the bolt and timing belt plate.
Using SST, remove the crankshaft timing pulley.
SST 09950–50012 (09951–05010, 09952–05010,
09953–05010, 09953–05020, 09954–05010)
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the sensor part of the crankshaft timing
pulley.
SST
P20026
Author:
Date:
1304
EM–19
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
EM04P–03
INSPECTION
NO!
EM3336
1.
INSPECT TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt inside out.
Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact with
oil, water or steam.
Do not utilize timing belt tension when installing or removing the mount bolt of the camshaft timing pulley.
If there are any defects, as shown in the illustrations, check
these points:
(a) Premature parting
Check for proper installation.
Check the timing cover gasket for damage and
proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, check to see if
either camshaft is locked.
(c) If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt face,
check to see if there are nicks on the side of the idler
pulley lock and water pump.
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the belt,
check the belt guide and the alignment of each pulley.
(e) If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth, check timing
cover for damage and check gasket has been installed
correctly and for foreign material on the pulley teeth.
If necessary, replace the timing belt.
2.
(a)
INSPECT IDLER PULLEYS
Visually check the seal portion of the idler pulley for oil
leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the idler pulley.
P20042
A02309
(b) Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler pulley.
P12604
Author:
Date:
1305
EM–20
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
3.
(a)
–
TIMING BELT
INSPECT TIMING BELT TENSIONER
Visually check the seal portion of the tensioner for oil leakage.
HINT:
If there is only the faintest trace of oil on the seal on the push
rod side, the tensioner is all right.
If leakage is found, replace the tensioner.
A05058
(b)
Hold the tensioner with both hands and push the push rod
strongly as shown to check that it doesn’t move.
If the push rod moves, replace the tensioner.
NOTICE:
Never hold the tensioner push rod facing downward.
P18764
(c)
Measure the protrusion of the push rod from the housing
end.
Protrusion: 10.0 – 10.8 mm (0.394 – 0.425 in.)
If the protrusion is not as specified, replace the tensioner.
Protrusion
P18770
Author:
Date:
1306
EM–21
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
EM0YO–01
INSTALLATION
Inward
Sensor
A05060
Plate Washer
10 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
1.
(a)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the timing
pulley, and slide on the timing pulley.
(b) Install the timing pulley, facing the sensor side inward.
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the sensor part of the crankshaft timing
pulley.
(c) Install the timing belt plate with the bolt.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
2.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL NO.1 IDLER PULLEY
Adhesive: Part No. 08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the plate washer
and idler pulley with the pivot bolt.
Torque: 34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
Check that the pulley bracket moves smoothly.
A01802
3.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Install the idler pulley with the bolt.
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
Check that the idler pulley moves smoothly.
A05055
4.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL RH CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Face the flange side of the timing pulley outward.
Align the knock pin on the camshaft with the knock pin
groove of the timing pulley, and slide on the timing pulley.
Author:
Date:
1307
EM–22
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(c)
RH
SST
Fulcrum
Length
–
TIMING BELT
Using SST, install the pulley bolt.
SST 09249–63010, 09960–10010 (09962–01000,
09963–01000)
Torque: 88 N·m (900 kgf·cm, 65 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 340 mm (13.39
in.).
SST
P20069
LH
5.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL LH CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
Face the flange side of the timing pulley inward.
Align the knock pin on the camshaft with the knock pin
groove of the timing pulley, and slide on the timing pulley.
(c)
Using SST, install the pulley bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–01000)
Torque: 125 N·m (1,300 kgf·cm, 94 ft·lbf)
6.
(a)
SET NO.1 CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
Crankshaft Timing Pulley Position:
Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt to the crankshaft.
Crankshaft Timing Pulley Position:
Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing marks of the
crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump body.
SST
P12762
(b)
P18811
(c)
SST
Camshaft Timing Pulley Positions:
Using SST, turn the camshaft pulley, align the timing
marks of the timing pulley and No.3 timing belt cover.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–01000)
A05063
Author:
Date:
1308
EM–23
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
5th
2nd 6th
3rd
4th
1st
A02338
TIMING BELT
7.
INSTALL TIMING BELT
NOTICE:
The engine should be cold.
(a) Remove any oil or water on the pulleys, and keep them
clean.
NOTICE:
Only wipe the pulleys; do not use any cleansing agent.
(b) Face the front mark on the timing belt forward.
(c) Align the installation mark on the timing belt with the timing mark of the crankshaft timing pulley.
(d) Align the installation marks on the timing belt with the timing marks of the camshaft timing pulleys.
(e) Install the timing belt in this order:
1st: Crankshaft timing pulley
2nd: Water pump pulley
3rd: LH camshaft timing pulley
4th: No.2 idler pulley
5th: RH camshaft timing pulley
6th: No.1 idler pulley
8.
(a)
(c)
SET TIMING BELT TENSIONER
Using a press, slowly press in the push rod using 981 –
9,807 N (100 – 1,000 kgf, 200 – 2,205 lbf) of pressure.
Align the holes of the push rod and housing, pass a 1.27
mm hexagon wrench through the holes to keep the setting position of the push rod.
Release the press.
(d)
Install the dust boot to the tensioner.
9.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSIONER
Temporarily install the tensioner with the 2 bolts.
Alternately tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 27 N·m (280 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
Remove the 1.27 mm hexagon wrench from the tensioner.
(b)
1.27 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
–
A05064
A05065
(c)
1.27 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
A05066
Author:
Date:
1309
EM–24
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
10.
(a)
CHECK VALVE TIMING
Slowly turn the crankshaft 2 revolutions, and align the timing marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump
body.
NOTICE:
Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
P18808
(b)
Check that the timing marks of the RH and LH timing pulleys with the timing marks of the No.3 timing belt cover as
shown in the illustration.
If the marks do not align, remove the timing belt and reinstall it.
(c) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
11. INSTALL RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Torque: 28 N·m (290 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
A05052
12.
(a)
INSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
Check that the timing belt cover gasket has no cracks or
peeling, etc.
If the gasket has cracks or peeling, etc., replace it using these
steps:
Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all
the old gasket material.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Length = 1,410 mm (55.51 in.)
(b)
(c)
P12983
Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and
install the gasket evenly to the part of the timing belt
cover shaded black in the illustration.
After installing the gasket, press down on it so that
the adhesive firmly sticks to the timing belt cover.
Install the timing belt cover with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
Install the engine wire protector clamps to the No.3 timing
belt cover.
13. INSTALL TIMING BELT GUIDE
Install the timing belt guide, facing the cup side outward.
P18815
Author:
Date:
1310
EM–25
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
14.
(a)
INSTALL NO.1 TIMING BELT COVER
Check that the timing belt cover gaskets have cracks or
peeling, etc.
If the gasket has cracks or peeling, etc., replace it using these
steps:
Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all
the old gasket material.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Length = 240 mm (9.45 in.)
Join
Line
Join
Line
Length = 460 mm
(18.11 in.)
P12982
Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and
install the gasket evenly to the part of the timing belt
cover shaded black in the illustration.
NOTICE:
When joining 2 gaskets, do not leave a gap between them.
Cut off any excess gasket.
After installing the gasket, press down on it so that
the adhesive firmly sticks to the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
15. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the pulley,
and slide on the pulley.
(b) Using SST, install the pulley bolt.
SST 09213–54015 (91651–60855), 09330–00021
Torque: 215 N·m (2,200 kgf·cm, 159 ft·lbf)
SST
A04693
16. INSTALL NO.2 GENERATOR BRACKET
Install the generator bracket with the pivot bolt and nut. Do not
tighten the bolt yet.
Torque: (Nut): 28 N·m (290 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
P18816
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
INSTALL NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET,
ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD, NO.2 RH ENGINE
MOUNTING STAY (M/T) AND RH ENGINE MOUNTING
STAY (See page EM–76)
CONNECT GROUND STRAP CONNECTORS
CONNECT ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR HOSE TO
WATER OUTLET
INSTALL PS PUMP DRIVE BELT
INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
(See page CH–16)
Author:
Date:
1311
EM–26
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
TIMING BELT
22. INSTALL RH FENDER APRON SEAL
23. INSTALL RH FRONT WHEEL
24. VEHICLE ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise, shock, slippage, correct shift points
and smoothly operation.
Author:
Date:
1312
EM–27
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
CYLINDER HEAD
EM04R–05
COMPONENTS
RH Fender Apron Seal
64 (650, 47)
32 (320, 23)
Generator
Drive Belt
RH Engine Mounting Stay
64 (650, 47)
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Bracket
PS Pump Drive Belt
MAF Meter
Connector
EVAP Hose
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Stay (M/T)
43 (440, 32)
Air Cleaner
Cap Assembly
PS Pump
EGR Vacuum Hose
Air Filter
Gasket
Gasket
Gasket
56 (570, 41)
Front Exhaust Pipe
Bracket
62 (630, 46)
Stay
33 (330, 24)
33 (330, 24)
62 (630, 46)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A06651
Author:
Date:
1313
EM–28
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Air Intake Chamber Stay
PS Pressure Tube
12 (120,9)
19.5 (200, 14)
39 (400,29)
No.1 Engine
Hanger
43 (440,32)
Gasket
V–Bank Cover
No.2 EGR Pipe
Throttle Position
Sensor Connector
Gasket
Brake Booster
Vacuum Hose
VSV Connector
for EGR
Engine Wire
EGR Valve Position
Sensor Connector
IAC Valve
Accelerator Cable
Connector
VSV Connector for
EVAP
Ground Cable
Ground Cable
Throttle Cable
Ground Strap
DLC1
PCV Hose
Air Intake Chamber
Assembly
Purge Hose
Vacuum
Hose
Air Assist Hose
Water Bypass Hose
Gasket
VSV Connector for ACIS
Engine Coolant
15 (150,11)
Reservoir Hose
Water Bypass
ECT Sender
Hose
Gauge Connector
Upper Radiator
Hose
ECT Sensor
Connector
Grand Strap
Connector
15 (150,11)
Water Outlet
Gasket
EGR Gas Temperature
Sensor Connector
Water Bypass Hose
Retainer
Fuel Inlet Hose
Heater Hose
Intake Manifold Assembly
Ignition Coil
Connector
Gasket
Injector Connector
Ignition Coil
Spark Plug
High–Tension Cord Set
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A06657
Author:
Date:
1314
EM–29
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Timing Belt
No.2 Timing Belt Cover
Gasket
RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Timing Belt Guide
28 (290, 21)
No.2 Generator
Bracket
No.1 Timing Belt Cover
Gasket
Crankshaft
Pulley
215 (2,200, 159)
Engine Wire
Protector
No.2 Idler Pulley
RH Camshaft Timing Pulley
125 (1,300, 94)
*88 (900, 65)
43 (440, 32)
LH Camshaft
Timing Pulley
125 (1,300, 94)
Dust Boot
Timing Belt Tensioner
27 (280, 20)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
* For use with SST
A05070
Author:
Date:
1315
EM–30
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
M/T and California A/T
RH Exhaust Manifold
34 (350,25)
Engine Wire
RH Exhaust
Manifold Stay
Engine Wire
Protector
Gasket
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Connector
Engine Wire Protector
20 (200, 14)
RH Exhaust Manifold
(Except M/T and California A/T)
49 (500, 36)
RH
Exhaust
Manifold
Stay
(Except M/T and Calif. A/T)
x6
12 (120, 9)
Cylinder Head Rear Plate
No.1 EGR Pipe
Gasket
PS Pump Bracket
Ground Strap
O–Ring
43 (440, 32)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1)
Connector
Gasket
No.3 Timing
Belt Cover
Water Inlet
Pipe
Collar
Bushing
Camshaft
Position Sensor
Connector
Gasket
Camshaft Position Sensor
x6
20 (200, 14)
Engine Wire
Gasket
x6
49 (500, 36)
California A/T
Oil Dipstick Guide
34 (350,25)
LH Exhaust
Manifold Stay
(Except M/T and
California A/T )
LH Exhaust Manifold
(Except California A/T)
O–Ring
x6
LH Exhaust
Manifold Stay
49 (500, 36)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
LH Exhaust Manifold
A06635
Author:
Date:
1316
EM–31
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
LH Cylinder Head Cover
Adjusting Shim
Valve Lifter
Keeper
Spring Retainer
Valve Spring
Wave Washer
Spring Seat
Gasket
Oil Seal
Camshaft Gear
Spring
Spark Plug
Tube Gasket
LH Intake Camshaft
Valve Guide Bushing
Snap Ring
Valve
Camshaft
Sub–Gear
LH Exhaust Camshaft
RH Cylinder Head Cover
Gasket
Wave Washer
See Page EM–57
1st 54 (550, 40)
2nd Turn 90°
18 (185, 13)
x8
Snap Ring
Camshaft Gear Spring
Camshaft Sub–Gear
Semi–Circular
Plug
Semi–Circular Plug
LH Cylinder Head
RH Exhaust
Camshaft
RH Intake Camshaft
16 (160, 12)
Camshaft
Bearing cap
RH Cylinder
Head
Camshaft Oil Seal
RH Cylinder
Head Gasket
LH Cylinder Head
Gasket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A02013
Author:
Date:
1317
EM–32
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM04S–05
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
7.
Hexagon
Clip
S04528
8.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(l)
(n)
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP ASSEMBLY AND AIR
FILTER
REMOVE ENGINE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EM–71)
REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
REMOVE V–BANK COVER
Using a 5 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 nuts.
Disconnect the 2 clips, and remove the cover.
REMOVE HIGH–TENSION CORD SET
(See page IG–7)
REMOVE AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
Disconnect the accelerator cable.
Disconnect the A/T throttle cable.
Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
Disconnect the EGR gas temperature sensor connector.
Disconnect the EGR valve position sensor connector.
Disconnect the VSV connector for the ACIS.
Disconnect the VSV connector for the EVAP.
Disconnect the VSV connector for the EGR.
Disconnect the DLC1 from the bracket on the intake air
control valve.
Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the PS pressure tube
from the No.1 engine hanger.
Disconnect the PCV hose from the PCV valve on the RH
cylinder head.
Disconnect the ground strap and cable from the intake air
control valve for the ACIS.
Disconnect the ground cable from the air intake chamber.
(n)
(m)
(t)
(r)
A06658
(o)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(r)
(p)
(s)
(s)
(q)
S05049
Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air
intake chamber.
Disconnect the 2 water bypass hoses from the throttle
body.
Disconnect the air assist hose from the throttle body.
Disconnect the purge hose from the pipe on emission
control valve set.
Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the vacuum tank for
the ACIS.
Author:
Date:
1318
EM–33
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
Chamber Stay
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(t)
Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the emission control valve set.
(u)
(v)
(w)
Remove the 2 bolts and No.1 engine hanger.
Remove the 2 bolts and air intake chamber stay.
Remove the 4 nuts, No.2 EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
(x)
Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2 bolts, 2
nuts, the air intake chamber assembly and gasket.
Engine
Hanger
EGR
Pipe
S04790
8 mm Hexagon
Wrench
S04791
9.
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 6 injector connectors.
(b) Disconnect the fuel inlet hose from the fuel filter.
CAUTION:
Perform connecting operations of the fuel tube connector
(quick type) after observing the precautions.
(See page SF–1)
(c) Disconnect the heater hose from the intake manifold.
(b)
(c)
A01807
(d)
Remove the 9 bolts, 2 nuts, 2 plate washers, the intake
manifold, delivery pipes and injectors assembly.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the injectors when removing
the delivery pipes.
Pay attention to put any hung load on the injector to
and from the side direction.
A01808
Author:
Date:
1319
EM–34
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
P20049
REMOVE WATER OUTLET
Disconnect the ECT sender gauge connector.
Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
Disconnect the ground strap (connector).
Disconnect the radiator hose.
Disconnect the engine coolant reservoir hose.
(f)
(g)
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and 2 plate washers.
Disconnect the water bypass hose, and remove the water
outlet.
Remove the 2 gaskets.
REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
(See page CH–6)
REMOVE PS PUMP (See page SR–21)
REMOVE IGNITION COILS
REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page EM–15)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(See page EM–15)
REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY (See page EM–15)
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
(a)
Clamp
CYLINDER HEAD
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(h)
11.
Gasket
–
Clamp
(b)
REMOVE NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
Disconnect the 3 engine wire clamps from the timing belt
cover.
Remove the 6 bolts and timing belt cover.
Clamp
A05077
19.
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE PROTECTOR FROM
REAR SIDE
Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire protector
from the RH cylinder head and water inlet.
S04786
Author:
Date:
1320
EM–35
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
20.
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE AND PROTECTOR
FROM RH SIDE
Remove the 5 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire and protector from the RH cylinder head cover.
S04787
21.
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE PROTECTOR FROM LH
SIDE
Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the engine wire protector
from the LH cylinder head cover.
A01812
22.
Rear
Plate
(a)
(b)
23.
Ground
Strap
(a)
Inlet Pipe
S04789
(b)
DISCONNECT CYLINDER HEAD REAR PLATE
FROM LH CYLINDER HEAD
Remove the nut, and disconnect the ground strap.
Remove the bolt, and disconnect the rear plate.
DISCONNECT WATER INLET PIPE FROM LH
CYLINDER HEAD AND WATER INLET
Remove the bolt, and disconnect the inlet pipe from the
water inlet.
Remove the O–ring from the inlet pipe.
24. REMOVE NO.1 EGR PIPE
Remove the 4 nuts, EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
P18773
Author:
Date:
1321
EM–36
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
25.
(a)
M/T and California A/T
(b)
(c)
(d)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
REMOVE RH EXHAUST MANIFOLD
California A/T:
Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Except California A/T:
Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
connector.
Remove the bolt, nut and exhaust manifold stay.
Remove the 6 nuts, exhaust manifold and gasket.
Manifold
Stay
Except M/T and California A/T
Manifold
Stay
A06649
26. REMOVE PS PUMP BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and pump bracket.
P18769
27.
(a)
California A/T
(b)
Manifold
Stay
(c)
(d)
28.
REMOVE LH EXHAUST MANIFOLD
California A/T:
Disconnect the A/F sensor connector.
Except California A/T:
Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
connector.
Except M/T:
Remove the bolt, nut and exhaust manifold stay.
Remove the 6 nuts, exhaust manifold and gasket.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Except California A/T
Manifold Stay
(Except M/T)
A01522
Author:
Date:
1322
EM–37
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
29.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
REMOVE OIL DIPSTICK AND GUIDE
Remove the bolt holding the dipstick guide to the LH cylinder head.
Pull out the dipstick guide together with the dipstick from
the No.1 oil pan.
Remove the O–ring from the dipstick guide.
O–Ring
P12710
30. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVERS
Remove the 8 bolts, cylinder head cover and gasket. Remove
the 2 cylinder head covers.
A01816
31. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS OF RH CYLINDER HEAD
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be held level while it is being removed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head
receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the following steps should be carried out.
(a)
Intake
Align
Intake
Remove the intake camshaft.
(1) Align the timing marks (2 dot marks) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears by turning the camshaft with
a wrench.
P12811
(2)
Secure the exhaust camshaft sub–gear to the main
gear with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Main Gear
Sub–Gear
Thread diameter
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 – 20 mm (0.63 – 0.79 in.)
Service Bolt
P12871
Author:
Date:
1323
EM–38
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
HINT:
When removing the camshaft, mark certain that the torsional
spring force of the sub–gear has been eliminated by the above
operation.
(3)
Intake
2
6
10
(4)
1
5
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Remove the 5 bearing caps and intake camshaft.
9
8
7
4
3
P12780
Exhaust
1
5
9
7
3
(b)
2
6
10
Remove the exhaust camshaft.
(1) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(2) Remove the 5 bearing caps, oil seal and exhaust
camshaft.
8
4
P12888
32. REMOVE CAMSHAFTS OF LH CYLINDER HEAD
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be held level while it is being removed. If the
camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head
receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the following steps should be carried out.
(a)
Intake
Remove the intake camshaft.
(1) Align the timing marks (1 dot mark) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears by turning the camshaft with
a wrench.
Align
P12917
Author:
Date:
1324
EM–39
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(2)
Secure the exhaust camshaft sub–gear to the main
gear with a service bolt.
Recommended service bolt:
Intake
Service Bolt
Main Gear
Sub–Gear
P12873
5
1
9
7
3
6
(c)
2
6 mm
Thread pitch
1.0 mm
Bolt length
16 – 20 mm (0.63 – 0.79 in.)
HINT:
When removing the camshaft, make sure that the torsional
spring force of the sub–gear has been eliminated by the above
operation.
(b)
Intake
Thread diameter
Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts, in
several passes, in the sequence shown.
Remove the 5 bearing caps and intake camshaft.
10
8
4
P12958
Exhaust
(d)
2
1
6
10
5
9
7
HINT:
8
4
3
Remove the exhaust camshaft.
(1) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(2) Remove the 5 bearing caps, oil seal and exhaust
camshaft.
Arrange the camshafts in the correct order.
Arrange the bearing caps in the correct order.
P12886
33.
(a)
DISASSEMBLE EXHAUST CAMSHAFTS
Mount the hexagonal wrench head portion of the camshaft in a vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
P12596
Author:
Date:
1325
EM–40
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(b)
Using SST, turn the sub–gear counterclockwise, and remove the service bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–00500)
(c)
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Remove the wave washer, camshaft sub–gear, and camshaft gear spring.
SST
P12797
HINT:
Arrange the camshaft sub–gears and gear springs (RH and LH
side).
P12590
34.
(a)
Recessed Head Bolt
REMOVE CYLINDER HEADS
Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the cylinder
head (recessed head) bolt on each cylinder head, then repeat for the other side, as shown.
8 mm Hexagon Wrench
Front
P12816
Author:
Date:
1326
EM–41
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
7
5
3
4
6
8
1
4
6
8
1
2
7
5
3
Front
CYLINDER HEAD
(b)
Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 cylinder head (12
pointed head) bolts on each cylinder head, in several
passes, in the sequence shown, then repeat for the other
side, as shown. Remove the 16 cylinder head bolts and
plate washers.
NOTICE:
Head warpage or cracking could result from removing
bolts in an incorrect order.
12 Pointed Head Bolt
2
–
P12735
(c)
P12424
Lift the cylinder head from the dowels on the cylinder
block and place the 2 cylinder heads on wooden blocks
on a bench.
HINT:
If the cylinder head is difficult to lift off, pry between the cylinder
head and cylinder block with a screwdriver.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the cylinder head and cylinder block.
Author:
Date:
1327
EM–42
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM04T–03
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE VALVE LIFTERS AND SHIMS
HINT:
Arrange the valve lifters and shims in the correct order.
P12683
2.
(a)
SST
(b)
REMOVE VALVES
Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove the 2
keepers.
SST 09202–70020 (09202–00010)
Remove the spring retainer, valve spring and valve.
(c)
Using needle–nose pliers, remove the oil seal.
(d)
Using compressed air and a magnetic finger, remove the
spring seat by blowing air.
P12476
P12686
Magnetic Finger
HINT:
Arrange the valves, valve springs, spring seats and spring retainers in the correct order.
P12720
Author:
Date:
1328
EM–43
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM0YP–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
CLEAN TOP SURFACES OF PISTONS AND
CYLINDER BLOCK
Turn the crankshaft, and bring each piston to top dead
center (TDC). Using a gasket scraper, remove all the carbon from the piston top surface.
P12689
(b)
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material
from the cylinder block surface.
(c) Using compressed air, blow carbon and oil from the bolt
holes.
CAUTION:
Protect your eyes when using high pressure compressed
air.
P12492
2.
REMOVE GASKET MATERIAL
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material from the
cylinder block contact surface.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block contact surface.
P12700
3.
CLEAN COMBUSTION CHAMBERS
Using a wire brush, remove all the carbon from the combustion
chambers.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to scratch the cylinder block contact surface.
P12701
4.
CLEAN CYLINDER HEADS
Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the cylinder
head.
P12703
Author:
Date:
1329
EM–44
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
5.
CLEAN VALVE GUIDE BUSHINGS
Using a valve guide bushing brush and solvent, clean all the
guide bushings.
P12755
6.
INSPECT FOR FLATNESS
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the
surfaces contacting the cylinder block and the manifolds for
warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cylinder head.
P12733
7.
INSPECT FOR CRACKS
Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion chamber, intake
ports, exhaust ports and cylinder block surface for cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
P12702
8.
(a)
(b)
CLEAN VALVES
Using a gasket scraper, chip off any carbon from the valve
head.
Using a wire brush, thoroughly clean the valve.
EM0580
Author:
Date:
1330
EM–45
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
9.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE STEMS AND GUIDE BUSHINGS
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
guide bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
5.510 – 5.530 mm (0.2169 – 0.2177 in.)
(b)
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the valve
stem.
Valve stem diameter:
P12754
(c)
Z00052
Intake
5.470 – 5.485 mm (0.2154 – 0.2159 in.)
Exhaust
5.465 – 5.480 mm (0.2152 – 0.2157 in.)
Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement from the
guide bushing guide bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
Intake
0.025 – 0.060 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust
0.030 – 0.065 mm (0.0012 – 0.0026 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
Intake
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the clearance is greater than maximum, replace the valve and
guide bushing.
10.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT AND GRIND VALVES
Grind the valve enough to remove pits and carbon.
Check that the valve is ground to the correct valve face
angle.
Valve face angle: 44.5°
44.5°
Z00054
(c)
Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum margin thickness: 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than minimum, replace the valve.
Margin Thickness
EM0181
Author:
Date:
1331
EM–46
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(d)
Overall Length
EM2534
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Check the valve overall length.
Standard overall length:
Intake
95.45 mm (3.5779 in.)
Exhaust
95.40 mm (3.7559 in.)
Minimum overall length:
Intake
94.95 mm (3.7382 in.)
Exhaust
94.90 mm (3.7362 in.)
If the overall length is less than minimum, replace the valve.
(e) Check the surface of the valve stem tip for wear.
If the valve stem tip is worn, resurface the tip with a grinder or
replace the valve.
NOTICE:
Do not grind off more than minimum.
EM0255
11.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT AND CLEAN VALVE SEATS
Using a 45° carbide cutter, resurface the valve seats.
Remove only enough metal to clean the seats.
Check the valve seating position.
Apply a light coat of prussian blue (or white lead) to the
valve face. Lightly press the valve against the seat. Do not
rotate valve.
P12704
(c)
Width
P12729
45°
30°
Check the valve face and seat for the following:
If blue appears 360° around the face, the valve is
concentric. If not, replace the valve.
If blue appears 360° around the valve seat, the
guide and face are concentric. If not, resurface the
seat.
Check that the seat contact is in the middle of the
valve face with the following width:
1.0 – 1.4 mm (0.039 – 0.055 in.)
If not, correct the valve seats as follows:
(1) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use 30°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
1.0 – 1.4 mm
Z03988
Author:
Date:
1332
EM–47
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
(2)
75°
45°
CYLINDER HEAD
If the seating is too low on the valve face, use 75°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
1.0 – 1.4 mm
Z03989
(d)
(e)
Hand–lap the valve and valve seat with an abrasive compound.
After hand–lapping, clean the valve and valve seat.
P12705
12.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE SPRINGS
Using a steel square, measure the deviation of the valve
spring.
Maximum deviation: 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
If the deviation is greater than maximum, replace the valve
spring.
Deviation
EM0988
(b)
Using vernier calipers, measure the free length of the
valve spring.
Free length: 45.50 mm (1.7913 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the valve spring.
EM0801
(c)
Using a spring tester, measure the tension of the valve
spring at the specified installed length.
Installed tension:
186 – 206 N (19.0 – 21.0 kgf, 41.9 – 46.3 lbf)
at 33.8 mm (1.331 in.)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace the valve
spring.
EM0281
Author:
Date:
1333
EM–48
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
13.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT FOR RUNOUT
Place the camshaft on V–blocks.
Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at the
center journal.
Maximum circle runout: 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, replace the camshaft.
EM1628
14. INSPECT CAM LOBES
Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height.
Standard cam lobe height:
Intake
42.11 – 42.21 mm (1.6579 – 1.6618 in.)
Exhaust
41.96 – 42.06 mm (1.6520 – 1.6559 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
EM2011
Intake
41.96 mm (1.6520 in.)
Exhaust
41.81 mm (1.6461 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than minimum, replace the camshaft.
15. INSPECT CAMSHAFT JOURNALS
Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter.
Journal diameter:
Intake
26.949 – 26.965 mm (1.0610 – 1.0616 in.)
Exhaust
26.959 – 26.975 mm (1.0613 – 1.0620 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance.
EM2538
16. INSPECT CAMSHAFT BEARINGS
Check that bearings for flaking and scoring.
If the bearings are damaged, replace the bearing caps and cylinder head as a set.
A05236
Author:
Date:
1334
EM–49
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
17.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Plastigage
–
CYLINDER HEAD
INSPECT CAMSHAFT JOURNAL OIL CLEARANCE
Clean the bearing caps and camshaft journals.
Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the camshaft journal.
P13009
(d)
Install the bearing caps. (See page EM–57)
Torque: 16 N·m (160 kgf·cm, 12 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the camshaft.
(e) Remove the bearing caps.
P12892
(f)
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
Intake
0.035 – 0.072 mm (0.0014 – 0.0028 in.)
Exhaust
0.025 – 0.062 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
P13004
Intake
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Exhaust
0.09 mm (0.0035 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps and cylinder head
as a set.
(g) Completely remove the Plastigage.
(h) Remove the camshafts.
18.
(a)
(b)
P12891
INSPECT CAMSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Install the camshafts. (See page EM–57)
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while
moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.040 – 0.090 mm (0.0016 – 0.0035 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps and cylinder
head as a set.
Author:
Date:
1335
EM–50
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(c)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Remove the camshafts.
19.
(a)
P12960
Free Distance
INSPECT CAMSHAFT GEAR BACKLASH
Install the camshafts without installing the exhaust cam
sub–gear. (See page EM–57)
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash.
Standard backlash:
0.020 – 0.200 mm (0.0008 – 0.0079 in.)
Maximum backlash: 0.30 mm (0.0188 in.)
If the backlash is greater then maximum, replace the camshafts.
(c) Remove the camshafts.
20. INSPECT CAMSHAFT GEAR SPRING
Using vernier calipers, measure the free distance between the
spring ends.
Free distance: 18.2 – 18.8 mm (0.712 – 0.740 in.)
If the free distance is not as specified, replace the gear spring.
EM3322
21.
(a)
INSPECT VALVE LIFTERS AND LIFTER BORES
Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore diameter
of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter:
31.000 – 31.018 mm (1.2205 – 1.2212 in.)
P12685
(b)
EM6368
Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter.
Lifter diameter:
30.966 – 30.976 mm (1.2191 – 1.2195 in.)
(c) Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the lifter
bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.024 – 0.050 mm (0.0009 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the lifter.
If necessary, replace the cylinder head.
Author:
Date:
1336
EM–51
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
22. INSPECT AIR INTAKE CHAMBER
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the
surface contacting the intake manifold for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the chamber.
P12400
23. INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the
surface contacting the cylinder head and air intake chamber for
warpage.
Maximum warpage:
Cylinder Head Side
Air intake chamber side
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
Cylinder head side
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the manifold.
Air Intake Chamber Side
Z09167
24. INSPECT EXHAUST MANIFOLDS
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the
surface contacting the cylinder head for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.50 mm (0.0196 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the manifold.
RH Side
LH Side
Z09168
Author:
Date:
1337
EM–52
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
25.
INSPECT 12 POINTED HEAD CYLINDER HEAD
BOLTS
Using vernier calipers, measure the tension portion diameter of
the bolt.
Standard outside diameter:
8.95 – 9.05 mm (0.3524 – 0.3563 in.)
Minimum outside diameter: 8.75 mm (0.3445 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the bolt.
P12496
Author:
Date:
1338
EM–53
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM0YQ–01
REPLACEMENT
80 – 100°C
1.
(a)
REPLACE VALVE GUIDE BUSHINGS
Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 – 100°C (176 –
212°F).
(b)
Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bushing.
SST 09201–01055, 09950–70010 (09951–07100)
(c)
Using a caliper gauge, measure the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head.
P12688
SST
P12803
P12956
Both intake and exhaust
Bushing bore diameter
mm (in.)
Bushing size
10.295 – 10.313
(0.4053 – 0.4060)
Use STD
10.345 – 10.363
(0.4073 – 0.4080)
Use O/S 0.05
Intake
34.5 mm
(1.358 in.)
(d) Select a new guide bushing (STD or O/S 0.05).
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is greater than
10.313 mm (0.4060 in.), machine the bushing bore to the following dimension:
10.345 – 10.363 mm (0.4073 – 0.4080 in.)
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is greater than
10.363 mm (0.4080 in.), replace the cylinder head.
HINT:
Different bushings are used for the intake and exhaust.
(e) Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80 – 100°C (176 –
212°F).
Exhaust
40.5 mm
(1.594 in.)
P11510
Author:
Date:
1339
EM–54
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(f)
SST
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bushing to
the specified protrusion height.
SST 09201–01055, 09950–70010 (09951–07100)
Protrusion height:
Intake
11.1 – 11.3 mm (0.437 – 0.453 in.)
Exhaust
8.9 – 9.3 mm – (0.350 – 0.366 in.)
P12802
(g)
Using a sharp 5.5 mm reamer, ream the guide bushing to
obtain the standard specified clearance (See page
EM–43) between the guide bushing and valve stem.
2.
(a)
(b)
REPLACE SPARK PLUG TUBE GASKETS
Bend up the tab on the ventilation baffle plate which prevents the gasket from the slipping out.
Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the gasket.
(c)
Using needle–nose pliers, pry out the gasket.
(d)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new gasket until its surface is flush with the upper edge of the cylinder head cover.
SST 09608–03071
Apply a light coat of MP grease to the gasket lip.
Return the ventilation plate tab to its original position.
Z09124
P13235
P13236
SST
(e)
(f)
P13224
Author:
Date:
1340
EM–55
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM04V–04
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all sliding and rotating surfaces.
Replace all gaskets and oil seals with new ones.
1.
INSTALL SPARK PLUG TUBES
HINT:
When using a new cylinder head, spark plug tubes must be
installed.
(a) Apply adhesive to the end of the spark plug tube.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent
Adhesive
10 – 15 mm (0.39 – 0.59 in.)
P11511
(b)
Protrusion
Using a press, press in a new spark plug tube until there
is 42.4 – 43.4 mm (1.669 – 1.709 in.) protruding from the
camshaft bearing cap installation surface of the cylinder
head.
NOTICE:
Avoid pressing a new spark plug tube in too far by measuring the amount of the protrusion while pressing.
P12572
2.
INSTALL PCV PIPES
HINT:
When using a new cylinder head, PCV pipe must be installed.
Using a wooden block and hammer, tap in a new PCV pipe until
its top side is flush with the cylinder head edge.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder head edge.
Flush
P12869
3.
(a)
SST
INSTALL VALVES
Using SST, push in a new oil seal.
SST 09201–41020
P12719
Author:
Date:
1341
EM–56
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
Intake
CYLINDER HEAD
HINT:
The intake valve oil seal is light brown and the exhaust valve oil
seal is gray.
NOTICE:
Pay much attention when assembling the oil seal for intake
and exhaust. Assembling the wrong one may cause a failure.
Exhaust
Mark
TMC made
”NOK”
TMMK made
”FN , IN”
Light Brown Surface
–
Gray Surface
Z19062
(b)
Install the valve (1), spring seat (2), valve spring (3) and
spring retainer (4).
(c)
Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the 2
keepers around the valve stem.
SST 09202–70020 (09202–00010)
(4)
(3)
(2)
(1)
P12668
SST
P12476
(d)
Using a plastic–faced hammer and the valve stem (not in
use) tip wound with vinyl tape, lightly tap the valve stem
tip to assure proper fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not do damage the valve stem tip.
4.
INSTALL VALVE LIFTERS AND SHIMS
(a) Install the valve lifter and shim.
(b) Check that the valve lifter rotates smoothly by hand.
A05246
Author:
Date:
1342
EM–57
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
EM0YR–01
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
PLACE CYLINDER HEAD ON CYLINDER BLOCK
Place 2 new cylinder head gaskets in position on the cylinder block.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction.
(b) Place the 2 cylinder heads in position on the cylinder head
gaskets.
P12393
2.
INSTALL 12 POINTED HEAD CYLINDER HEAD BOLTS
HINT:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 progressive
steps (steps (c) and (e)).
If any bolt is broken or deformed, replace it.
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
(b) Install the plate washer to the cylinder head bolt.
(c) Install and uniformly tighten the cylinder head bolts on
each cylinder head, in several passes, in the sequence
shown, then repeat for the other side, as shown.
Torque: 54 N·m (550 kgf·cm, 40 ft·lbf)
If any of the cylinder head bolts does not meet the torque specification, replace the cylinder head bolt.
12 Pointed Head Bolt
Front
7
2
4
6
5
3
1
8
5
3
1
8
7
2
4
6
P12736
(d)
(e)
Painted Mark
90°
Front
90°
(f)
Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt head with paint.
Retighten the cylinder head bolts by 90° in the numerical
order shown.
Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to the
front.
P25742
Author:
Date:
1343
EM–58
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
3.
(a)
Recessed Head Bolt
(b)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
INSTALL RECESSED HEAD CYLINDER HEAD BOLTS
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the cylinder head bolts.
Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, install the cylinder head
bolt on each cylinder head, then repeat for the other side,
as shown.
Torque: 18.5 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
8 mm Hexagon Wrench
Front
P12814
4.
(a)
ASSEMBLE EXHAUST CAMSHAFTS
Mount the hexagonal wrench head portion of the camshaft in a vise.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
P12595
(b)
(3)
(2)
Install the camshaft gear spring (1) and camshaft sub–
gear (2).
HINT:
Attach the pins on the gears to the gear spring ends.
(c) Install the wave washer (3).
(1)
Z09320
(d)
Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
P12590
Author:
Date:
1344
EM–59
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(e)
SST
(f)
Main Gear
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Using SST, align the holes of the camshaft main gear and
sub–gear by turning camshaft sub–gear counterclockwise, and temporarily install a service bolt.
SST 09960–10010 (09962–01000, 09963–00500)
Align the gear teeth of the main gear and sub–gear, and
tighten the service bolt.
Sub–Gear
P12974
5.
INSTALL CAMSHAFTS OF RH CYLINDER HEAD
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be held level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not level, the portion of the cylinder head receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing
the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the following
steps should be carried out.
Exhaust
90°
(a)
Install the exhaust camshaft.
(1) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshaft.
(2) Place the exhaust camshaft at 90° angle of timing
mark (2 dot marks) on the cylinder head.
(3) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
P12963
(4)
Exhaust
Install the oil seal to the camshaft.
Front
P12804
(5)
(6)
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
Apply seal packing to the No.1 bearing cap as
shown.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Exhaust
Seal
Packing
A02008
Author:
Date:
1345
EM–60
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
Exhaust
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(b)
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
(c)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts, in
several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 N·m (160 kgf·cm, 12 ft·lbf)
P12890
Exhaust
10
6
2
4
8
9
(d)
5
1
3
7
P12887
Intake
(e)
Install the Intake camshaft.
(1) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshaft.
(2) Align the timing marks (2 dot marks) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears.
(3) Place the intake camshaft on the cylinder head.
Align
P12875
(4)
Intake
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
P12798
(5)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(6) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 N·m (160 kgf·cm, 12 ft·lbf)
Intake
5
1
2
9
6
10
3
7
4
8
P25422
Author:
Date:
1346
EM–61
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
(7)
Intake
CYLINDER HEAD
Remove the service bolt.
Service Bolt
P12870
6.
INSTALL CAMSHAFTS OF LH CYLINDER HEAD
NOTICE:
Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the
camshaft must be held level while it is being installed. If the
camshaft is not level, the portion of the cylinder head receiving the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing
the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this, the following
steps should be carried out.
(a)
Exhaust
90°
Install the exhaust camshaft.
(1) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshaft.
(2) Place the exhaust camshaft at 90° angle of timing
mark (1 dot mark) on the cylinder head.
(3) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
P12884
(4)
Exhaust
Install the oil seal to the camshaft.
Front
P12805
(5)
(6)
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
Apply seal packing to the No.1 bearing cap as
shown.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Exhaust
Seal
Packing
A02008
Author:
Date:
1347
EM–62
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(7)
Exhaust
–
CYLINDER HEAD
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
P12962
(8)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(9) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 N·m (160 kgf·cm, 12 ft·lbf)
Exhaust
9
5
10
6
1
2
3
4
7
8
P25421
(b)
Intake
Align
Install the intake camshaft.
(1) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshaft.
(2) Align the timing marks (1 dot mark) of the camshaft
drive and driven gears.
(3) Place the intake camshaft on the cylinder head.
P12874
(4)
Intake
Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations.
P12961
(5)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and
under the heads of bearing cap bolts.
(6) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 N·m (160 kgf·cm, 12 ft·lbf)
Intake
2
4
8
6 10
9
5
1
3
7
P12959
Author:
Date:
1348
EM–63
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
Intake
Service Bolt
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(7) Remove the service bolt.
7.
CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(See page EM–4)
Turn the camshaft and position the cam lobe upward, and
check and adjust the valve clearance.
P12872
8.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SEMI–CIRCULAR PLUGS
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material.
Apply seal packing to the semi–circular plug grooves.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
(c)
Install the 4 semi–circular plugs to the cylinder heads.
Seal Packing
P13274
Semi–Circular Plug
Front
P12813
Author:
Date:
1349
EM–64
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
: Seal Packing
9.
(a)
RH Side
(b)
(c)
Front
–
CYLINDER HEAD
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVERS
Apply seal packing to the cylinder heads as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Install the gasket to the cylinder head cover.
Install the cylinder head cover with the 8 bolts. Uniformly
tighten the bolts in several passes. Install the 2 cylinder
head covers.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
LH Side
P12812
10.
(a)
M/T and California A/T
(b)
Manifold
Stay
Except M/T and California A/T
(c)
(d)
INSTALL RH EXHAUST MANIFOLD
Install a new gasket and the exhaust manifold with the 6
nuts. Uniformly tighten the nuts in several passes.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
Install the exhaust manifold stay with the bolt and nut. Alternately tighten the bolt and nut.
Torque:
M/T and California A/T
34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
Except M/T and California A/T:
20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
California:
Connect the A/F sensor connector.
Except California:
Connect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
connector.
Manifold
Stay
A06649
11. INSTALL NO.1 EGR PIPE
Install 2 new gaskets and the EGR pipe with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
12. INSTALL PS PUMP BRACKET
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
P18773
Author:
Date:
1350
EM–65
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
New O–Ring
P12710
(e)
14.
15.
(a)
California A/T
(b)
Manifold
Stay
Except California A/T
(c)
(d)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
INSTALL OIL DIPSTICK AND GUIDE
Install a new O–ring to the dipstick guide.
Apply soapy water to the O–ring.
Push in the dipstick guide end into the guide hole of the
No.1 oil pan.
Install the dipstick guide with the bolt.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
Install the dipstick.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSTALL LH EXHAUST MANIFOLD
Install a new gasket and the exhaust manifold with the 6
nuts. Uniformly tighten the nuts in several passes.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
Except M/T:
Install the exhaust manifold stay with the bolt and nut. Alternately tighten the bolt and nut.
Torque:
California A/T:
34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
Except California A/T:
20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
California:
Connect the A/F sensor connector.
Except California:
Connect the heated oxygen sensor (bank 2 sensor 1)
connector.
Manifold Stay
(Except M/T)
A01522
Rear
Plate
Ground
Strap
Inlet Pipe
S04789
16.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSTALL WATER INLET PIPE
Install a new O–ring to the water inlet pipe.
Apply soapy water to the O–ring.
Connect the water inlet pipe to the water inlet.
Install the bolt holding the water inlet pipe to the cylinder
head.
Torque: 19.5 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
17. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD REAR PLATE
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
18. INSTALL ENGINE WIRE PROTECTOR
19. INSTALL NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gaskets have no cracks
or peeling, etc.
If the gaskets have cracks or peeling etc., replace them using
these steps:
Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all
the old gasket material.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Author:
Date:
1351
EM–66
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
L = 72 mm (2.83 in.) L = 180 mm
(7.09 in.)
L = 133 mm (5.24 in.)
L = 180 mm (7.09 in.)
Join
Line
Join
Line
L = 335 mm (13.19 in.)
L = Length
New Gasket
A05194
Z14262
6
4
10
7
1
9
CYLINDER HEAD
Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and
install the gasket evenly to the part of the timing belt
cover shaded black in the illustration.
NOTICE:
When joining 2 gaskets, do not leave a gap between them.
Cut off any excess gasket.
After installing the gasket, press down on it so that
the adhesive firmly sticks to the timing belt cover.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
(c) Install the 3 engine wire clamps to the timing belt cover.
20. INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY (See page EM–21)
21. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(See page EM–21)
22. INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page EM–21)
23. INSTALL SPARK PLUGS
24. INSTALL IGNITION COILS
25. INSTALL PS PUMP DRIVE BELT
26. INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
(See page SR–28)
27. INSTALL WATER OUTLET
(a) Install 2 new gaskets.
(b) Connect the water outlet to the bypass hose.
(c) Install the water outlet with the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and 2 plate
washers. Alternately tighten the bolts and nuts.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the seal surface of the water outlet with the
stud bolt.
(d) Connect the ECT sender gauge connector.
(e) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
(f)
Connect the ground strap (connector).
(g) Connect the radiator hose.
(h) Connect the engine coolant reservoir hose.
28.
(a)
2
8
–
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY
Install the intake manifold, delivery pipe and injectors assembly with the 9 bolts, 2 plate washers and 2 nuts. Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts, in several passes, in the
sequence shown.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
11
5
3
A01808
Author:
Date:
1352
EM–67
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
8 mm Hexagon
Wrench
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(b) Connect the fuel inlet hose to the fuel filter.
CAUTION:
Perform connecting operations of the fuel tube connector
(quick type) after observing the precaution.
(See page SF–1)
(c) Connect the heater hose to the intake manifold.
29. RETIGHTEN WATER OUTLET MOUNTING BOLTS
AND NUTS
Tighten the 2 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
30. INSTALL AIR INTAKE CHAMBER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, install a new gasket and
the air intake chamber assembly with the 2 bolts and 2
nuts. Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts in several
passes.
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
S04791
Chamber Stay
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
EGR
Pipe
Engine
Hanger
S04790
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(r)
(s)
(t)
(u)
(v)
Install 2 new gaskets and No.2 EGR pipe with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Install the No.1 engine hanger with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Install the air intake chamber stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19.5 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Connect the PCV hose to the PCV valve on the RH cylinder head.
Connect the ground strap and cable to the intake air control valve for the ACIS.
Connect the ground cable and strap with the nut.
Torque: 14.5 N·m (145 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
Connect the ground cable to the air intake chamber.
Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air intake
chamber.
Connect the 2 water bypass hoses to the throttle body.
Connect the air assist hose to the throttle body.
Connect the purge hose to the emission control valve set.
Connect the 2 vacuum hoses to the vacuum tank for the
ACIS.
Connect the engine wire clamp to the emission control
valve set.
Install the PS pressure tube with the 2 nuts.
Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
Connect the IAC valve connector.
Connect the EGR gas temperature sensor connector.
Connect the EGR valve position sensor connector.
Connect the VSV connector for the ACIS.
Connect the VSV connecter for the EVAP.
Connect the VSV connector for the EGR.
Author:
Date:
1353
EM–68
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER HEAD
(w)
Connect the DLC1 to the bracket on the intake air control
valve.
(x) Connect the accelerator cable.
(y) Connect the A/T throttle cable.
31. INSTALL HIGH–TENSION CORD SET
32. INSTALL V–BANK COVER
33. INSTALL RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
(See page EM–76)
34. INSTALL AIR FILTER AND AIR CLEANER CAP
ASSEMBLY
35. INSTALL RH FENDER APRON SEAL
36. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(See page EM–76)
37. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
38. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
39. VEHICLE ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise, shock, slippage, correct shift points
and smoothly operation.
40. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1354
EM–69
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
ENGINE UNIT
EM04X–04
COMPONENTS
No.2 Cooling Fan Connector
Upper Radiator Support
Radiator Upper Hose
Radiator Assembly
RH Fender
Apron
Seal
Upper Radiator
Support
No.1 Cooling
Fan Connector
Washer
Hose for
Windshield
No.1 ECT Switch
Wire Connector
Lower Radiator Support
O–Ring
Drain Lower Radiator
Plug Support
EGR Vacuum Hose
Generator
Drive
Belt
Hood
EVAP Hose
MAF Meter
Connector
PS Pump
Drive Belt
Hold–Down
Clamp
Air Filter
Air Cleaner Case
Air Cleaner
Cap Assembly
43 (440, 32)
PS Pump
Battery
Insulator
A/C Compressor
Connector
A/C Compressor
Battery
Generator Drive
Belt Adjusting
Bar Bracket
Battery
Tray
Radiator Lower Hose
25 (250, 18)
LH Fender
Apron Seal
A/T
Oil Cooler
Hose
Gasket
Actuator Cover
56 (570, 41)
Accelerator Cable
Gasket
Cruise Control
Actuator
Gasket
Front Exhaust Pipe
62 (630, 46)
Cruise Control
Actuator
Connector
Bracket
Stay
33 (330, 24)
33 (330, 24)
62 (630, 46)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A06650
Author:
Date:
1355
EM–70
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
RH Drive Shaft
Tie Rod End
LH Drive Shaft
64 (650, 47)
49 (500, 36)
294 (3,000, 217)
32 (320, 23)
Engine Moving
Control Rod
RH Engine
Mounting Stay
64 (650, 47)
Lower Suspension Arm
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Stay (M/T)
64 (650, 47)
127 (1,300, 94)
Rear Engine
Mounting
Insulator
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Bracket
Engine and Transaxle
Assembly
Front Engine
Mounting Insulator
66 (670, 48)
64 (650, 47)
Transaxle
Control Cable
48 (490, 35)
TMC Made 80 (820,59)
TMMK Made
Green Clolr Bolt 66 (670, 48)
Silver Clolr Bolt 44 (450,32)
64 (650, 47)
Engine Mounting Absorber
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A06646
Author:
Date:
1356
EM–71
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
EM04Y–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
S05048
(e)
11.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
REMOVE BATTERY AND TRAY
REMOVE HOOD
REMOVE ENGINE FENDER APRON SEALS
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
DISCONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP ASSEMBLY AND AIR
CLEANER CASE
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
REMOVE RADIATOR (See page CO–18)
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
Remove the 2 bolts holding the support stay to the support bracket.
Remove the 2 bolts holding the support bracket to the
front frame.
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
Remove the 4 nuts holding the front exhaust pipe to the
exhaust manifolds.
Remove the front exhaust pipe and 3 gaskets.
DISCONNECT CONNECTORS, CABLE, CLAMPS
AND HOSES
Disconnect the igniter connector on the LH fender apron.
Disconnect the noise filter connector on the LH fender
apron.
Disconnect the generator wire and connector.
Disconnect the starter wire and connector.
Disconnect the 2 ground strap connectors from the LH
fender apron.
Disconnect the 2 ground strap connectors from the RH
fender apron.
Disconnect the ground cable from the battery body bracket.
Disconnect the engine wire protector clamp from the battery body bracket.
Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the bracket on the
RH fender apron.
Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the bracket on the
fuel filter.
Author:
Date:
1357
EM–72
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
(k)
Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air
intake chamber.
(l)
Disconnect the engine coolant reservoir hose from the
water outlet.
(m) Disconnect the heater hose from the intake manifold.
(n) Disconnect the heater hose from the water inlet housing.
(o) Disconnect the fuel inlet hose from the fuel filter.
CAUTION:
Perform disconnecting operation of the fuel tube connector (quick type) after observing the precautions.
(See page SF–6)
(p) Disconnect the purge hose from the pipe on the emission
control valve set.
(q) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the vacuum tank for
the ACIS.
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
S04497
13.
14.
15.
16.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
17.
Bracket
Connector
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE FROM CABIN
Remove the No.2 instrument lower panel.
Disconnect the 3 ECM connectors.
Disconnect the 3 cowl wire connectors from the connectors on the bracket.
Disconnect the grommet from the cowl panel, and pull out
the engine wire.
REMOVE DRIVE SHAFTS (See page SA–26)
M/T only:
REMOVE STARTER (See page ST–5)
M/T only:
DISCONNECT CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER AND
ACCUMULATOR WITHOUT DISCONNECTING TUBE
DISCONNECT A/C COMPRESSOR FROM ENGINE
Disconnect the A/C compressor connector.
Remove the drive belt.
Remove the 4 bolts, nut and drive belt adjusting bar
bracket.
Disconnect the A/C compressor from the engine.
DISCONNECT TRANSAXLE CONTROL CABLE(S)
FROM TRANSAXLE
B00881
Author:
Date:
1358
EM–73
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
18.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
ENGINE UNIT
DISCONNECT PS PUMP FROM ENGINE
Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the PS pressure tube
from the No.1 engine hanger.
Loosen the 2 bolts, and remove the drive belt.
Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the PS pump from
the engine.
P18775
19.
M/T
(a)
DISCONNECT TRANSAXLE FROM LH ENGINE
MOUNTING INSULATOR
M/T:
Remove the 3 bolts holding the transaxle to the mounting
insulator.
S05393
A/T
(b)
A/T:
Remove the 4 bolts holding the transaxle to the mounting
insulator.
20.
DISCONNECT REAR ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
FROM FRONT FRAME
Remove the 2 hole plugs.
Remove the 4 nuts holding the front frame to the mounting bracket.
Z18907
(a)
(b)
P18752
21. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING ABSORBER
Remove the 4 bolts and mounting absorber.
A05426
Author:
Date:
1359
EM–74
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
22.
DISCONNECT FRONT ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR FROM FRONT FRAME
Remove the 3 bolts holding the mounting insulator to the front
frame.
P18755
23.
(a)
Engine
Hanger
P19478
ATTACH ENGINE SLING DEVICE TO ENGINE
HANGERS
Install the No.2 engine hanger in the correct direction.
Part No.:
No.2 engine hanger
12282–20020
Bolt
91621–60822
Torque: 19.5 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(b) Attach the sling device to the engine hangers.
CAUTION:
Do not attempt to hang the engine by hooking the chain to
any other part.
24. REMOVE RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Remove the 3 bolts and RH engine mounting stay.
S04501
25.
M/T only:
REMOVE NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Remove the 2 bolts and No.2 RH engine mounting stay.
S05451
Author:
Date:
1360
EM–75
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
26.
REMOVE ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD AND
NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts, control rod and mounting bracket.
S04754
27.
Lift
S04993
REMOVE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
FROM VEHICLE
(a) Lift the engine out of the vehicle slowly and carefully.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to hit the PNP switch.
Make sure the engine is clear of all wiring, hoses and
cables.
(b) Place the engine and transaxle assembly onto the stand.
28. REMOVE FRONT ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
FROM ENGINE
Remove the 4 bolts and mounting insulator.
29. REMOVE REAR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
AND BRACKET ASSEMBLY FROM ENGINE
Remove the 4 bolts, the mounting insulator and bracket assembly.
30. SEPARATE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE
E153 M/T (See page MX–4)
A541E A/T (See page AX–23)
Author:
Date:
1361
EM–76
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
EM04Z–04
INSTALLATION
1.
Lower
S04992
ASSEMBLE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE
E153 M/T (See page MX–4)
A541E A/T (See page AX–23)
2.
INSTALL REAR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Install the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
3.
INSTALL FRONT ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Install the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
4.
INSTALL ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY IN
VEHICLE
(a) Attach the engine sling device to the engine hangers.
(b) Lower the engine into the engine compartment.
Tilt the transaxle downward, lower the engine and clear
the LH mounting.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to hit the park/neutral position switch.
(c) Keep the engine level, and align RH and LH mountings
with the body bracket.
5.
INSTALL NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
AND ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD
Install the mounting moving control rod and No.2 RH engine
mounting bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
S04754
6.
M/T only:
INSTALL NO.2 RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Install the No.2 RH engine mounting stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
S05451
7.
INSTALL RH ENGINE MOUNTING STAY
Install the RH mounting stay with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 32 N·m (320 kgf·cm, 23 ft·lbf)
S04501
Author:
Date:
1362
EM–77
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
8.
CONNECT FRONT ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR
Connect the mounting insulator with the 3 bolts.
Torque:
TMC made: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
TMMK made:
44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf) for silver color bolt
66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf) for green color bolt
P18755
9.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING ABSORBER
Install the engine mounting absorber with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 48 N·m (490 kgf·cm, 35 ft·lbf)
A05426
10.
(a)
(b)
CONNECT REAR ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
Connect the mounting insulator with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
Install the 2 hole plugs.
P18752
M/T
11.
(a)
CONNECT LH ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
M/T:
Connect the mounting insulator with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
(b)
A/T:
Connect the mounting insulator with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 64 N·m (650 kgf·cm, 47 ft·lbf)
REMOVE ENGINE SLING DEVICE
CONNECT TRANSAXLE CONTROL CABLE(S) TO
TRANSAXLE
S05393
A/T
12.
13.
Z18907
Author:
Date:
1363
EM–78
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
14.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
ENGINE UNIT
INSTALL PS PUMP
Install the PS pump with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
Install the drive belt.
Connect the PS pressure tube with the 2 nuts.
P18775
15.
(a)
C
B
A
A
Connector
Bracket
A
B00881
(b)
(c)
16.
17.
18.
19.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR
Install the A/C compressor and drive belt adjusting bar
bracket with the 4 bolts and nut.
Torque:
Bolt A: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Bolt B: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Nut C: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Install the drive belt.
Connect the A/C compressor connector.
M/T only:
INSTALL CLUTCH RELEASE CYLINDER AND
ACCUMULATOR
M/T only:
INSTALL STARTER (See page ST–19)
INSTALL DRIVE SHAFTS (See page SA–32)
CONNECT ENGINE WIRE TO CABIN
Push in the engine wire through the cowl panel. Install the
grommet.
Connect the 3 engine ECM connectors.
Connect the 3 cowl wire connectors to the connectors on
the bracket.
Install the No.2 instrument lower panel.
S04497
20.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
CONNECT CONNECTORS, CABLE, CLAMPS AND
HOSES
Connect the igniter connector on the LH fender apron.
Connect the noise filter connector on the LH fender
apron.
Connect the generator connector and wire.
Connect the starter connector and wire.
Connect the 2 ground strap connectors to the RH fender
apron.
Author:
Date:
1364
EM–79
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
(f)
Connect the 2 ground strap connectors to the LH fender
apron.
(g) Connect the DLC1 to the RH fender apron.
(h) Connect the ground cable to the battery body bracket.
(i)
Connect the engine wire protector clamp to the battery
body bracket.
(j)
Connect the engine wire clamp to the bracket on the RH
fender apron.
(k) Connect the engine wire clamp to the bracket on the fuel
filter.
(l)
Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air intake
chamber.
(m) Connect the engine coolant reservoir hose to the water
outlet.
(n) Connect the heater hose to the intake manifold.
(o) Connect the heater hose to the water inlet housing.
(p) Connect the fuel inlet hose to the fuel filter.
CAUTION:
Perform connecting operations of the fuel tube connector
(quick type) after observing the precautions.
(See page SF–6)
(q) Connect the purge hose to the pipe on the emission control valve set.
(r)
Connect the 2 vacuum hoses to the vacuum tank for the
ACIS.
21.
(a)
(b)
(c)
S05048
(d)
(e)
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
Temporarily install 3 new gaskets and the front exhaust
pipe with the 2 bolts and 6 nuts.
Tighten the 4 nuts holding the exhaust manifolds to the
front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
Tighten the 2 bolts and 2 nuts holding the front exhaust
pipe to the center exhaust pipe.
Torque: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Install the support stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
INSTALL RADIATOR (See page CO–24)
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
INSTALL AIR CLEANER CAP ASSEMBLY AND AIR
CLEANER CASE
CONNECT ACCELERATOR CABLE
INSTALL ENGINE FENDER APRON SEALS
INSTALL BATTERY TRAY AND BATTERY
Author:
Date:
1365
EM–80
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE UNIT
28. INSTALL HOOD
29. FILL ENGINE WITH OIL
30. FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
31. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
32. PERFORM ROAD TEST
Check for abnormal noise, shock, slippage, correct shift points
and smooth operation.
33. RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT AND OIL LEVELS
Author:
Date:
1366
EM–81
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM050–03
COMPONENTS
Knock Sensor Connector
Knock Sensor
39 (400, 29)
No.2 ECT Switch Connector
Engine Wire Band
Engine Wire
Water Inlet Housing
(With Water Inlet)
x8
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
Gasket
28 (290, 21)
No.2 Idler Pulley Bracket
EGR Cooler
Water Seal Plate
9 (90, 78 in.·lbf)
Gasket
14.5 (145, 10)
Water Pump
Engine Coolant
Drain Union
Oil Filter Union
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
O–Ring
Oil Pressure Switch
Oil Pump
Crankshaft
Front Oil Seal
Oil Filter
x9
10mm Head 7.8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
12mm Head 19.5 (200,14)
25 (250, 18)
Oil Pressure Switch
Connector
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
Connector
A/C Compressor
Housing Bracket
No.1 Oil Pan
x 15 or 17
or 0
or 0
Gasket
10mm Head 8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
12mm Head 19.5 (200,14)
Engine Wire
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
Oil Strainer
Gasket
No.2 Oil Pan
Generator
x 10
Drain Plug
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Precoated part
45 (460, 33)
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
A06640
Author:
Date:
1367
EM–82
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
No.1 Piston Ring
No.2 Piston Ring
Oil Ring (Side Rail)
Oil Ring (Expander)
Snap Ring
Piston Pin
Piston
Snap Ring
Connecting Rod Bushing
Connecting Rod
Connecting Rod Bearing
Connecting Rod Cap
See Page EM–101
1st 24.5 (250, 18)
2nd Turn 90°
Crankshaft
Rear Oil Seal
x6
Seal Washer
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
Rear Oil Seal
Retainer
Cylinder Block
Upper Crankshaft
Thrust Washer
Upper Main Bearing
Crankshaft
Lower Crankshaft
Thrust Washer
Lower Main Bearing
Main Bearing Cap
27 (275, 20)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
See Page EM–101
1st 22 (225, 16)
2nd Turn 90°
Seal Washer
Z18551
Author:
Date:
1368
EM–83
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM051–04
DISASSEMBLY
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
7.
M/T:
REMOVE FLYWHEEL
A/T:
REMOVE DRIVE PLATE
INSTALL ENGINE TO ENGINE STAND FOR
DISASSEMBLY
REMOVE TIMING BELT AND PULLEYS
(See page EM–15)
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD (See page EM–32)
REMOVE GENERATOR, ADJUSTING BAR AND
BRACKET ASSEMBLY
Disconnect the 2 wire clamps from the wire brackets.
Remove the 3 nuts, the generator, adjusting bar and
bracket assembly.
REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
(See page LU–1)
S04921
8.
REMOVE A/C COMPRESSOR HOUSING BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and compressor housing bracket.
P12946
9.
REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY BRACKET
Remove the 2 bolts and idler pulley bracket.
P18761
10.
(a)
(b)
SST
REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Disconnect the 2 knock sensor connectors.
Using SST, remove the 2 knock sensors.
SST 09816–30010
P12389
Author:
Date:
1369
EM–84
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
P18762
Water
Seal
Plate
Oil Filter
Union
12 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
11. REMOVE WATER INLET HOUSING
(a) Remove the engine wire band.
(b) Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the bracket.
(c) Remove the 8 bolts, 2 nuts and water inlet housing.
12. REMOVE WATER PUMP (See page CO–6)
13. REMOVE NO.2 OIL PAN (See page LU–9)
14. REMOVE OIL STRAINER (See page LU–9)
15. REMOVE NO.1 OIL PAN (See page LU–9)
16. REMOVE OIL PUMP (See page LU–9)
17. REMOVE OIL FILTER (See page LU–9)
18. REMOVE OIL FILTER UNION
Using a 12 mm hexagon wrench, remove the oil filter union.
19. REMOVE WATER SEAL PLATE
Remove the 2 nuts and seal plate.
20. REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT DRAIN UNION
Coolant
Drain
Union
P18763
21. REMOVE EGR COOLER
Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts, EGR cooler and gasket.
P12410
22.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
Remove the 6 bolts.
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal retainer by prying
the portions between the oil seal retainer and main bearing cap.
P12508
P12695
23. CHECK CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.15 – 0.30 mm (0.0059 – 0.0118 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
connecting rod assembly(s). If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
Author:
Date:
1370
EM–85
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Connecting rod thickness:
20.80 – 20.85 mm (0.8189 – 0.8209 in.)
24.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CONNECTING ROD CAPS AND CHECK
OIL CLEARANCE
Check the matchmarks on the connecting rod and cap are
aligned to ensure correct reassembly.
Remove the 2 connecting rod cap bolts.
P13329
(c)
Using the 2 removed connecting rod cap bolts, remove
the connecting rod cap and lower bearing by wiggling the
connecting rod cap right and left.
HINT:
Keep the lower bearing inserted with the connecting rod cap.
P12707
(d) Clean the crank pin and bearing.
(e) Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and scratches.
If the crank pin or bearing is damaged, replace the bearings. If
necessary, replace the crankshaft.
P12696
(f)
Plastigage
Lay a strip of Plastigage across the crank pin.
P12728
Author:
Date:
1371
EM–86
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(g)
P12697
Install the connecting rod cap with the 2 bolts.
(See page EM–101)
Torque:
1st: 24.5 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
2nd: Turn extra 90°
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(h) Remove the 2 bolts, connecting rod cap and lower bearing. (See steps (b) and (c))
(i)
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.038 – 0.064 mm (0.0015 – 0.0025 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
P12698
HINT:
If replacing a bearing, replace it with one having the same number as marked on the connecting rod. There are 4 sizes of standard bearings, marked ”1”, ”2”, ”3” and ”4” accordingly.
Reference:
Standard bearing center wall thickness:
Mark
Number Mark
mm (in.)
”1”
1.484 – 1.487 (0.0584 – 0.0585)
”2”
1.487 – 1.490 (0.0585 – 0.0587)
”3”
1.490 – 1.493 (0.0587 – 0.0588)
”4”
1.493 – 1.496 (0.0588 – 0.0589)
(j)
Completely remove the Plastigage.
25.
REMOVE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
ASSEMBLIES
Using a ridge reamer, remove all the carbon from the top
of the cylinder.
Push the piston, connecting rod assembly and upper
bearing through the top of the cylinder block.
Number
Mark
P14127
(a)
(b)
HINT:
P12500
Keep the bearings, connecting rod and cap together.
Arrange the piston and connecting rod assemblies in the
correct order.
Author:
Date:
1372
EM–87
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
P12799
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
26. CHECK CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while prying
the crankshaft back and forth with a screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.04 – 0.24 mm (0.0016 – 0.0095 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than maximum, replace the
thrust washers as a set.
Thrust washer thickness:
1.930 – 1.980 mm (0.0760 – 0.0780 in.)
27. REMOVE MAIN BEARING CAPS AND CHECK OIL
CLEARANCE
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 main bearing cap
bolts and seal washers, in the several passes, in the sequence shown.
P12585
8
6
2
14
13
10
9
1
4 12
16 11
15
7
5
(b)
Uniformly loosen and remove the 16 main bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
(c)
Using a screwdriver, pry out main bearing caps. Remove
the 4 main bearing caps, lower bearings and (No.2 main
bearing cap only) 2 lower thrust washers.
3
P12752
P12603
NOTICE:
Pull up the main bearing cap little by little to the right and
the left by turns and pay attention not to damage the joint
surface of the cylinder block and the main bearing cap.
HINT:
Keep the lower bearing and main bearing cap together.
Arrange the main bearing caps and lower thrust washers
in correct order.
Joint Surface
S06200
Author:
Date:
1373
EM–88
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(d) Lift out the crankshaft.
HINT:
Keep the upper bearings together with the cylinder block.
(e) Clean each main journal and bearing.
(f)
Check each main journal and bearing for pitting and
scratches.
If the journal or bearing is damaged, replace the bearings. If
necessary, replace the crankshaft.
P12495
(g)
(h)
Plastigage
Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal.
P12980
(i)
P12954
Install the 4 main bearing caps. (See page EM–101)
Torque:
12 pointed head bolts:
1st: 22 N·m (225 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
2nd: Turn extra 90°
Hexagon head bolts:
27 N·m (275 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(j)
Remove the main bearing caps. (See steps (a) to (c) )
(k) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
No.1 and No.4 journals
0.014 – 0.036 mm (0.0006 – 0.0014 in.)
No.2 and No.3 journals
0.026 – 0.048 mm (0.0010 – 0.0019 in.)
Maximum clearance:
P12993
No.1 and No.4 journals
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
No.2 and No.3 journals
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the bearings. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
Author:
Date:
1374
EM–89
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
No.2
No.1
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
HINT:
If using a bearing, replace it with one having the same number.
If the number of the bearing cannot be determined, select the
correct bearing by adding together the numbers imprinted on
the cylinder block and crankshaft, then refer to the table below
for the appropriate bearing number. The No.1 and No.4 journal
bearings have 5 standard bearing sizes, marked ”3”, ”4”, ”5”, ”6”
and ”7” accordingly. The No.2 and No.3 journal bearings have
5 standard bearing sizes, marked ”1”, ”2”, ”3”, ”4” and ”5” accordingly.
No.3
No.4
Number Mark
No.2 No.3
No.4
No.1
No.1 and No.4 journal bearings
Total number
0–5
6 – 11
Use bearing
”3”
”4”
EXAMPLE:
Number Mark
Number
Mark
Cylinder block (A)
+
Crankshaft (B)
” ”: Number mark
12 – 17 18 – 23 24 – 28
”5”
”6”
”7”
Cylinder block ”06” (A)
+ Crankshaft ”08” (B)
= Total number 14 (Use bearing ”5”)
P12734
No.1 and No.4 journal standard bearings selection chart
Cylinder block number mark
Crankshaft
number mark
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
00
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
01
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
02
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
03
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
04
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
05
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
06
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
07
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
08
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
09
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
10
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
7
11
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
7
7
12
5
5
5
5
5
5
6
6
6
6
6
6
7
7
7
7
7
EXAMPLE:
Cylinder block ”06”, Crankshaft ”08”
= Use bearing ”5”
Author:
Date:
1375
EM–90
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
No.2 and No.3 journal bearings
Total number
Cylinder block (A)
+
Crankshaft (B)
0–5
6 – 11
Use bearing
”1”
”2”
EXAMPLE:
” ”: Number mark
12 – 17 18 – 23 24 – 28
”3”
”4”
”5”
Cylinder block ”06” (A)
+ Crankshaft ”08” (B)
= Total number 14 (Use bearing ”3”)
No.2 and No.3 journal standard bearings selection chart
Cylinder block number mark
Crankshaft
number mark
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
00
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
01
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
02
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
03
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
04
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
05
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
06
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
07
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
08
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
09
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
10
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
11
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
12
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
EXAMPLE:
Cylinder block ”06”, Crankshaft ”08”
= Use bearing ”3”
Author:
Date:
1376
EM–91
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Reference
Item
Mark
mm (in.)
Cylinder block main journal bore diameter
(A)
”00”
”01”
”02”
”03”
”04”
”05”
”06”
”07”
”08”
”09”
”10”
”11”
”12”
”13”
”14”
”15”
”16”
66.000 (2.5984)
66.001 (2.5985)
66.002 (2.5985)
66.003 (2.5985)
66.004 (2.5986)
66.005 (2.5986)
66.006 (2.5987)
66.007 (2.5987)
66.008 (2.5987)
66.009 (2.5988)
66.010 (2.5988)
66.011 (2.5989)
66.012 (2.5989)
66.013 (2.5989)
66.014 (2.5990)
66.015 (2.5990)
66.016 (2.5990)
Crankshaft main journal diameter (B)
”00”
”01”
”02”
”03”
”04”
”05”
”06”
”07”
”08”
”09”
”10”
”11”
”12”
61.000 (2.4016)
60.999 (2.4015)
60.998 (2.4015)
60.997 (2.4015)
60.996 (2.4014)
60.995 (2.4014)
60.994 (2.4013)
60.993 (2.4012)
60.992 (2.4012)
60.991 (2.4012)
60.990 (2.4012)
60.989 (2.4011)
60.988 (2.4011)
Standard bearing center wall thickness
(TMC made)
”1”
”2”
”3”
”4”
”5”
”6”
”7”
2.486 – 2.489 (0.0979 – 0.0980)
2.489 – 2.492 (0.0980 – 0.0981)
2.492 – 2.495 (0.0981 – 0.0982)
2.495 – 2.498 (0.0982 – 0.0983)
2.498 – 2.501 (0.0983 – 0.0985)
2.501 – 2.504 (0.0985 – 0.0986)
2.504 – 2.507 (0.0986 – 0.0987)
Standard bearing center wall thickness
(TMMK made)
”1”
”2”
”3”
”4”
”5”
”6”
”7”
2.485 – 2.488 (0.0978 – 0.0980)
2.488 – 2.491 (0.0980 – 0.0981)
2.491 – 2.494 (0.0981 – 0.0982)
2.494 – 2.497 (0.0982 – 0.0983)
2.497 – 2.500 (0.0983 – 0.0984)
2.500 – 2.503 (0.0984 – 0.0985)
2.503 – 2.506 (0.0985 – 0.0987)
(l)
28.
(a)
(b)
Completely remove the Plastigage.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT
Lift out the crankshaft.
Remove the 4 upper main bearings and 2 upper thrust
washers from the cylinder block.
HINT:
Arrange the main bearing caps, bearings and thrust washers in
the correct order.
Author:
Date:
1377
EM–92
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
29. CHECK FIT BETWEEN PISTON AND PISTON PIN
Try to move the piston back and forth on the piston pin.
If any movement is felt, replace the piston and pin as a set.
P12404
30.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON RINGS
Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2 compression
rings.
Remove the 2 side rails and oil ring by hand.
(b)
HINT:
Arrange the piston rings in the correct order only.
P12405
31.
(a)
DISCONNECT CONNECTING ROD FROM PISTON
Using a small screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
(b)
Gradually heat the piston to approx. 60°C (140°F).
(c)
Using a plastic–faced hammer and brass bar, lightly tap
out the piston pin and remove the connecting rod.
P12403
60°C
P12416
HINT:
The piston and pin are a matched set.
Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods and
bearings in the correct order.
P12415
Author:
Date:
1378
EM–93
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM0YS–01
INSPECTION
P12499
1.
REMOVE GASKET MATERIAL
Using a gasket scraper, remove all the gasket material from the
top surface of the cylinder block.
2.
CLEAN CYLINDER BLOCK
Using a soft brush and solvent, thoroughly clean the cylinder
block.
NOTICE:
If the cylinder is washed at high temperatures, the cylinder
liner sticks out beyond the cylinder block, so always wash
the cylinder block at a temperature of 45°C (113°F) or less.
3.
INSPECT TOP SURFACE OF CYLINDER BLOCK FOR
FLATNESS
Using a precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the
surface contacting the cylinder head gasket for warpage.
Maximum warpage: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If warpage is greater than maximum, replace the cylinder block.
Z09222
4.
INSPECT CYLINDER FOR VERTICAL SCRATCHES
Visually check the cylinder for vertical scratches.
If deep scratches are present, replace the cylinder block.
P12498
Author:
Date:
1379
EM–94
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
5.
INSPECT CYLINDER BORE DIAMETER
Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore diameter at
positions A, B and C in the thrust and axial directions.
Standard diameter:
87.500 – 87.512 mm (3.4449 – 3.4453 in.)
Maximum diameter: 87.52 mm (3.4457 in.)
If the diameter is greater than maximum, replace the cylinder
block.
1 Thrust
Direction
Front
2
1
A
2 Axial
Direction
10 mm
(0.39 in.)
B
C
10 mm
(0.39 in.)
Z09220
6.
REMOVE CYLINDER RIDGE
If the wear is less than 0.2 mm (0.008 in.), using a ridge reamer,
grind the top of the cylinder.
P12500
7.
INSPECT 12 POINTED HEAD MAIN BEARING CAP
BOLTS
Using vernier calipers, measure the tension portion diameter of
the bolt.
Standard diameter:
7.500 – 7.600 mm (0.2953 – 0.2992 in.)
Minimum diameter: 7.20 mm (0.2835 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the bolt.
P12497
8.
(a)
CLEAN PISTON
Using a gasket scraper, remove the carbon from the piston top.
P12507
Author:
Date:
1380
EM–95
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(b)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Using a groove cleaning tool or broken ring, clean the piston ring grooves.
P12491
(c) Using solvent and a brush, thoroughly clean the piston.
NOTICE:
Do not use a wire brush.
P12505
AISIN Made
RH Piston
23.2 mm
LH Piston
S06041
9.
(a)
INSPECT PISTON OIL CLEARANCE
AISIN made:
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at
right angles to the piston pin center line, 23.2 mm
(0.913 in.) from the piston head.
Piston diameter:
87.406 – 87.416 mm (3.4412 – 3.4416 in.)
(2) Measure the cylinder bore diameter in the thrust
directions. (See page EM–93)
(3) Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the
cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.084 – 0.106 mm (0.0033 – 0.0042 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.13 mm (0.0051 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace all the 6
pistons. If necessary, replace the cylinder block.
HINT:
The shape of the piston varies for the RH and LH banks. The
RH piston is marked with ”R”, the LH piston with ”L”.
Author:
Date:
1381
EM–96
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(b)
MAHLE Made
RH Piston
41.2 mm
LH Piston
MAHLE made:
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at
right angles to the piston pin center line, 41.2 mm
(1.622 in.) from the piston head.
Piston diameter:
87.453 – 87.467 mm (3.4430 – 3.4436 in.)
(2) Measure the cylinder bore diameter in the thrust
directions. (See inspection in cylinder block)
(3) Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the
cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.033 – 0.059 mm (0.0013 – 0.0023 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace all the 6
pistons. If necessary, replace the cylinder block.
HINT:
The shape of the piston varies for the RH and LH banks. The
RH piston is marked with ”R”, the LH piston with ”L”.
S06042
10. INSPECT PISTON RING GROOVE CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between new piston right and the wall of the ring groove.
Ring groove clearance:
No.1
0.020 – 0.070 mm (0.0008 – 0.0028 in.)
No.2
0.020 – 0.060 mm (0.0008 – 0.0024 in.)
If the clearance is not as specified, replace the piston.
P12504
11.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT PISTON RING END GAP
Insert the piston ring into the cylinder bore.
Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond the bottom of the ring travel, 105 mm (4.13 in.) from the top of the
cylinder block.
(c)
Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard end gap:
105 mm
P12583
No.1
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.0098 – 0.0138 in.)
No.2
0.35 – 0.45 mm (0.0138 – 0.0177 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
0.15 – 0.40 mm (0.0059 – 0.0157 in.)
Maximum end gap:
EM7639
No.1
0.95 mm (0.0374 in.)
No.2
1.05 mm (0.0413 in.)
Oil (Side rail)
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
Author:
Date:
1382
EM–97
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
If the end gap is greater than maximum, replace the piston ring.
If the end gap is greater than maximum, even with a new piston
ring, replace the cylinder block.
12. INSPECT PISTON PIN FIT
At 60°C (140°F), you should be able to push the piston pin into
the piston pin hole with your thumb.
P12506
13. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD ALIGNMENT
Using a rod aligner and feeler gauge, check the connecting rod
alignment.
Check for out–of–alignment.
Maximum out–of–alignment:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If bend is greater than maximum, replace the connecting rod assembly.
Z04012
Check for twist
Maximum twist:
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If twist is greater than maximum, replace the connecting rod assembly.
Z04011
14.
(a)
INSPECT PISTON PIN OIL CLEARANCE
Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the
connecting rod bushing.
Bushing inside diameter:
22.005 – 22.014 mm (0.8663 – 0.8667 in.)
EM6525
Author:
Date:
1383
EM–98
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(b)
(c)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin diameter.
Piston pin diameter:
21.997 – 22.006 mm (0.8660 – 0.8664 in.)
Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from the
bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.005 – 0.011 mm (0.0002 – 0.0004 in.)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
EM0227
15. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD BOLTS
Using vernier calipers, measure the tension portion diameter of
the bolt.
Standard diameter: 7.2 – 7.3 mm (0.284 – 0.287 in.)
Minimum diameter: 7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the bolt.
EM6347
16.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT FOR CIRCLE RUNOUT
Place the crankshaft on V–blocks.
Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout, as
shown in the illustration.
Maximum circle runout: 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than maximum, replace the crankshaft.
P12406
17.
(a)
P12493
INSPECT MAIN JOURNALS AND CRANK PINS
Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each main
journal and crank pin.
Main journal diameter:
60.988 – 61.000 mm (2.4011 – 2.4016 in.)
Crank pin diameter:
52.992 – 53.000 mm (2.0862 – 2.0866 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance.
(See page EM–83)
If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
(b) Check each main journal and crank pin for taper and out–
of–round as shown.
Maximum taper and out–of–round:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and out–of–round is greater than maximum, replace
the crankshaft.
Author:
Date:
1384
EM–99
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM0YT–01
REPLACEMENT
SST
1.
(a)
REPLACE CONNECTING ROD BUSHING
Using SST and a press, press out the bushing.
SST 09222–30010
(b)
Align the oil holes of a new bushing and the connecting
rod.
Using SST and a press, press in the bushing.
SST 09222–30010
EM6363
(c)
Oil
Hole
EM6364
(d)
Using a pin hole grinder, hone the bushing to obtain the
standard specified clearance (See page EM–93) between the bushing and piston pin.
(e)
Check the piston pin fit at normal room temperature. Coat
the piston pin with engine oil, and push it into the connecting rod with your thumb.
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
(See page LU–13)
EM6535
2.
P00326
3.
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT REAR OIL SEAL
HINT:
There are 2 methods ((a) and (b)) to replace the oil seal which
are as follows:
(a) If the rear oil seal retainer is removed from the cylinder
block.
(1) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the oil
seal.
P12589
Author:
Date:
1385
EM–100
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(2)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer
edge.
SST 09223–15030, 09950–70010 (09951–07100)
(3) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
SST
P12570
(b)
If the rear oil seal retainer is installed to the cylinder block.
(1) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(2) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape the screwdriver tip.
Cut Position
P12808
(3)
(4)
Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223–15030, 09950–70010 (09951–07100)
SST
P12810
Author:
Date:
1386
EM–101
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
EM053–04
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
1.
(a)
Thoroughly clean all parts to be assembled.
Before installing the parts, apply new engine oil to all sliding and rotating surfaces.
Replace all gaskets, O–rings and oil seals with new parts.
ASSEMBLE PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring at one
end of the piston pin hole.
HINT:
Be sure that end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the pin
hole cutout portion of the piston.
A05260
(b)
Gradually heat the piston to about 60°C (140°F).
(c)
(d)
Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
Align the front marks of the piston and connecting rod,
and push in the piston pin with your thumb.
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on the
other end of the piston pin hole.
60°C
P12417
AISIN Made
RH Piston
Front Mark
(2 Cavities)
(e)
HINT:
Be sure that end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the pin
hole cutout portion of the piston.
Front Mark
(Mold Mark)
LH Piston
Front Mark
(1 Cavity)
Front Mark
(Mold Mark)
S06044
Author:
Date:
1387
EM–102
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
MAHLE Made
RH Piston
Front Mark
(1 Cavity)
Front Mark
(Mold Mark)
LH Piston
Front Mark
(1 Cavity)
Front Mark
(Mold Mark)
S06043
2.
(a)
(b)
Code Mark
No.1
Code Mark
No.2
INSTALL PISTON RINGS
Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 compression
rings with the code mark facing upward.
Code mark:
No.1
1R, T or G1
No.2
2R, 2T or G2
Z09179
(c)
RH Piston
No.2
Lower Side Rail
Compression
Front Mark
Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as
shown.
NOTICE:
Do not align the ring ends.
Expander
No.1
Compression
or
Upper Side Rail
LH Piston
Lower Side Rail
Front Mark
No.2
Front
Mark
Compression
Expander
No.1
Compression
Upper Side Rail
S06058
Author:
Date:
1388
EM–103
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
3.
(a)
(b)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
INSTALL CONNECTING ROD BEARINGS
Align the bearing claw with the groove of the connecting
rod or connecting cap.
Install the bearings in the connecting rod and connecting
rod cap.
P12402
No.1 and No.4
No.2 and No.3
Upper
Lower
22.4 mm
19.0 mm
Z09177
4.
INSTALL MAIN BEARINGS
HINT:
Main bearings come in widths of 19.0 mm (0.748 in.) and
22.4 mm (0.882 in.). Install the 22.4 mm (0.882 in.) bearings in the No.1 and No.4 cylinder block journal positions
with the main bearing cap. Install the 19.0 mm (0.748 in.)
bearings in the No.2 and No.3 positions.
Upper bearings have an oil groove and oil holes; lower
bearings do not.
(a)
Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the cylinder
block, and push in the 4 upper bearings.
NOTICE:
Install the bearing with the oil hole in the cylinder block.
P12599
(b)
Align the bearing claw with the claw groove of the main
bearing cap, and push in the 4 lower bearings.
HINT:
A number is marked on each main bearing cap to indicate the
installation position.
Mark
1, 2, 3 or 4
A05263
5.
INSTALL UPPER THRUST WASHERS
Install the 2 thrust washers under the No.2 journal position of
the cylinder block with the oil grooves facing outward.
P12600
Author:
Date:
1389
EM–104
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
6.
PLACE CRANKSHAFT ON CYLINDER BLOCK
7.
PLACE MAIN BEARING CAPS AND LOWER THRUST
WASHERS ON CYLINDER BLOCK
Install the 2 thrust washers on the No.2 bearing cap with
the grooves facing outward.
P12495
(a)
A05264
(b)
Temporarily place the 4 main bearing caps level and let
them in their proper locations.
(c)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the main bearing cap bolts for the 12 pointed head.
Temporarily install the 8 main bearing cap bolts to the inside positions.
Insert the main bearing cap with your hand until the clearance between the main bearing cap and the cylinder
block will become less than 6 mm (0.23 in.) by making the
2 internal main bearing cap bolts as a guide.
A05265
(d)
(e)
Less than 6 mm
A05266
(f)
8.
Using a plastic–faced hammer, lightly tap the bearing cap
to ensure a proper fit.
INSTALL 12 POINTED HEAD MAIN BEARING CAP
BOLTS
HINT:
A05267
The main bearing cap bolts are tightened in 2 progressive
steps (steps (b) and (d)).
If any of the main bearing cap bolts is broken or deformed,
replace it.
Author:
Date:
1390
EM–105
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(a)
9
11
3
15
7
13
1
5
6
2
4
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the main bearing cap bolts.
(b) Install and uniformly tighten the 16 main bearing cap
bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 22 N·m (225 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
If any of the main bearing cap bolts does not meet the torque
specification, replace the main bearing cap bolt.
14
10
12
8
16
P12753
(c)
(d)
Painted Mark
90°
Front
90°
(e)
Mark the front of the main bearing cap bolts with paint.
Retighten the main bearing cap bolts by 90° in the numerical order shown.
Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to the
front.
P25741
9.
4
1
2
3
(a)
(b)
7
6
5
(c)
10.
8
P12586
INSTALL HEXAGON HEAD MAIN BEARING CAP
BOLTS
Install a new seal washer to the main bearing cap bolt.
Install and uniformly tighten the 8 main bearing cap bolts,
in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 27 N·m (275 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
CHECK CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
(See page EM–83)
Author:
Date:
1391
EM–106
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
11.
AISIN Made
INSTALL PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD
ASSEMBLES
Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly numbered
piston and connecting rod assemblies into each cylinder with
the front mark of the piston facing forward.
HINT:
The shape of the piston varies for the RH and LH banks. The
RH piston is marked with ”R”, the LH piston with ”L”.
Front
Front Mark
(2 Cavities)
RH Piston
Front
Front Mark
(1 cavity)
MAHLE Made
LH Piston
Front
Front Mark
(1 cavity)
RH Piston
Front
Front Mark
(1 cavity)
LH Piston
S06045
12.
(a)
(b)
PLACE CONNECTING ROD CAP ON CONNECTING
ROD
Match the numbered connecting rod cap with the connecting rod.
Align the pin dowels of the connecting rod cap with the
pins of the connecting rod, and install the connecting rod.
P12699
(c)
Front
13.
HINT:
Protrusion
Check that the protrusion of the connecting rod cap is facing in the correct direction.
INSTALL CONNECTING ROD CAP BOLTS
The connecting rod cap bolts are tightened in 2 progressive steps (steps (b) and (d)).
If any of the connecting rod cap bolts is broken or deformed, replace it.
P12801
Author:
Date:
1392
EM–107
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
(a)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the heads of the connecting rod cap bolts.
(b) Install and alternately tighten the 2 connecting rod cap
bolts in several passes.
Torque: 24.5 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
If any of the connecting rod cap bolts does not meet the torque
specification, replace the connecting rod cap bolts.
P12697
(c)
(d)
(e)
Painted Mark
90°
90°
Front
(f)
14.
P25743
15.
(a)
Mark the front of the connecting cap bolts with paint.
Retighten the cap bolts by 90° as shown.
Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to the
front.
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
CHECK CONNECTING ROD THRUST
CLEARANCE (See page EM–83)
INSTALL REAR OIL SEAL RETAINER
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the oil seal
retainer and cylinder block.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all
the oil packing (FIPG) material from the gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b)
A
A
B
Seal Width
2 – 3 mm
B
P12911
Apply seal packing to the oil seal retainer as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 2 – 3 mm (0.08
– 0.12 in.) opening.
Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be removed
and reapplied.
Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall cap.
(c) Install the oil seal retainer with the 6 bolts Uniformly tighten the bolt in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
16. INSTALL EGR COOLER
Install a new gasket and the EGR cooler with the 3 bolts and 2
nuts.
Torque: 9 N·m (90 kgf·cm, 78 in.·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1393
EM–108
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
17.
(a)
Seal Packing
(b)
P12477
A
A
B
Seal Width
3 – 5 mm
CYLINDER BLOCK
INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT DRAIN UNION
Apply seal packing to 2 or 3 threads.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00100 or equivalent
Install the drain union.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
HINT:
After applying the specified torque, rotate the drain union clockwise until its drain port is facing downward.
18. INSTALL WATER SEAL PLATE
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the seal plate
and cylinder block.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all
the old packing (FIPG) material from the gasket surfaces and sealing groove.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b)
B
–
Z09223
(c)
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
(a)
Apply seal packing to the seal plate as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00100 or equivalent
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 3 – 5 mm (0.12
– 0.20 in.) opening.
Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be removed
and reapplied.
Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall cap.
Install the seal plate with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 18 N·m (180 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
INSTALL OIL FILTER UNION
Torque: 30 N·m (310 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
INSTALL OIL FILTER (See page LU–15)
INSTALL OIL PUMP (See page LU–15)
INSTALL NO.1 OIL PAN (See page LU–15)
INSTALL OIL STRAINER (See page LU–15)
INSTALL NO.2 OIL PAN (See page LU–15)
INSTALL WATER PUMP (See page CO–8)
INSTALL WATER INLET HOUSING
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the water inlet housing and cylinder block.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all
the old packing (FIPG) material from the gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Author:
Date:
1394
EM–109
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
(b)
Seal Width 3 – 5 mm
P12909
3
1
6
(d)
(e)
7
8
CYLINDER BLOCK
Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
Apply seal packing to the water inlet housing as shown in
the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00100 or equivalent
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 3 – 5 mm (0.12
– 0.20 in.) opening.
HINT:
Avoid applying an excessive amount to the surface.
Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be removed
and reapplied.
Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall cap.
(c)
9
–
Install the water inlet housing with the 8 bolts and 2 nuts.
Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts, in several passes, in
the sequence shown.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
Install the engine wire band.
Install the engine wire clamp.
5
2
10
4
Z14261
27.
(a)
SST
(b)
28.
29.
P12389
INSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the 2 knock sensors.
SST 09816–30010
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Connect the 2 knock sensor connectors.
INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY BRACKET
Torque: 28 N·m (290 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR HOUSING BRACKET
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1395
EM–110
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
(a)
Adhesive
(b)
–
CYLINDER BLOCK
INSTALL OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
(See page LU–1)
INSTALL GENERATOR, BRACKET AND
ADJUSTING BAR ASSEMBLY
Torque: 43 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD (See page EM–57)
INSTALL TIMING PULLEYS AND BELT
(See page EM–21)
REMOVE ENGINE STAND
A/T:
INSTALL DRIVE PLATE
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324
or equivalent
Install the front spacer, drive plate and rear plate on the
crankshaft.
P00601
(c)
1
5
7
36.
4
3
Install and uniformly tighten the 8 bolts, in several passes,
in the sequence shown.
Torque: 83 N·m (850 kgf·cm, 61 ft·lbf)
M/T:
INSTALL FLYWHEEL (See step 35)
Torque: 83 N·m (850 kgf·cm, 61 ft·lbf)
6
8
2
A05416
Author:
Date:
1396
EM–111
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
EXHAUST SYSTEM
EXHAUST SYSTEM
EM0YU–01
COMPONENTS
California A/T
Ring
Heat Insulator
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
HINT:
Before installing the oxygen sensor, twist
the sensor wire counterclockwise 3 and
33 (330, 24)
1/2 turns.
After installing the sensor wire is not twisted.
If it is twisted, remove the oxygen sensor
Ring
Heat Insulator
and reinstall it.
Tailpipe
Heat Insulator
Gasket
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
56 (570, 41)
44 (450, 33)
56 (570, 41)
Center Exhaust Pipe
Heat Insulator
19 (195, 14)
Bracket
Gasket
Stay
Bracket
21 (210, 15)
Front Exhaust Pipe (Type A)
Gasket
Gasket
Type B
Front Exhaust Pipe
Bracket
62 (630, 46)
33 (330, 24)
Stay
33 (330, 24)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A06653
Author:
Date:
1397
EM–112
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
–
EXHAUST SYSTEM
Heat Insulator
Except California A/T
Heated Oxygen Sensor (Bank 1 Sensor 2)
HINT:
Before installing the oxygen sensor, twist
the sensor wire counterclockwise 3 and
1/2 turns.
After installing the sensor wire is not
twisted.
If it is twisted, remove the oxygen
sensor and reinstall it.
Ring
33 (330, 24)
Ring
Tailpipe
Heat Insulator
Heat Insulator
Gasket
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
56 (570, 41)
44 (450, 33)
Center Exhaust Pipe
56 (570, 41)
Heat Insulator
19 (195, 14)
Bracket
Stay
21 (210, 15)
Bracket
Gasket
Gasket
Gasket
M/T
Front Exhaust Pipe
Bracket
Stay
62 (630, 46)
33 (330, 24)
33 (330, 24)
Front Exhaust Pipe (A/T)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
A06652
Author:
Date:
1398
LU–1
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
LU03H–03
INSPECTION
10W – 30
5W – 30 PREFERRED
–20
–29
0
–18
20
–7
40
4
60
16
80
27
OIL AND FILTER
OIL AND FILTER
Recommended Viscosity (SAE) :
°F
°C
–
100
38
TEMPERATURE RANGE ANTICIPATED BEFORE NEXT OIL CHANGE
B00319
Curved
Tip
Insert
1.
CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, discoloring or thinning.
If the quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
API grade SJ, Energy–Conserving or ILSAC multigrade engine oil. SAE 5W–30 is the best choice for
your vehicle, for good fuel economy, and good starting in cold weather.
2.
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
After warming up the engine and then 5 minutes after the engine stop, oil level should be between ”L” and ”F” of the dipstick.
If low, check for leakage and add oil up to ”F” mark.
NOTICE:
Do not fill with engine oil above the ”F” mark.
When inserting the oil dipstick, insert the curved tip
of the dipstick facing the same direction as the curve
of the guide.
If the dipstick gets caught while inserting it, do not
force it in. Reconfirm the direction of the dipstick.
S05317
3.
REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH AND INSTALL OIL
PRESSURE GAUGE
4.
WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
5.
CHECK OIL PRESSURE
Oil pressure:
Oil Pressure Gauge
At idle
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi) or more
At 3,000 rpm
245 – 490 kPa (2.5 – 5.0 kgf/cm2, 36 – 71 psi)
S05298
6.
Adhesive
(a)
(b)
P13638
(c)
7.
REMOVE OIL PRESSURE GAUGE AND REINSTALL
OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Remove the oil pressure gauge.
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure switch.
Adhesive:
Part No. 08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE
242 or equivalent
Reinstall the oil pressure switch.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR OIL LEAKS
Author:
Date:
1647
LU–2
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL AND FILTER
LU03I–03
REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will
result in the removal of natural fats from the skin,
leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially harmful
contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
Care should be taken, therefore, when changing engine oil to minimize the frequency and length of time
your skin is exposed to used engine oil. Protective
clothing and gloves that cannot be penetrated by oil
should be worn. The skin should be thoroughly
washed with soap and water, or use water–less hand
cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use
gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
In order to preserve the environment, used oil and
used oil filters must be disposed of only at designated disposal sites.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug, and drain the oil into a container.
2.
(a)
SST
(b)
(c)
REPLACE OIL FILTER
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228–06501
Clean the oil filter contact surface on the oil filter mounting.
Lubricate the filter rubber gasket with clean engine oil.
S05318
(d)
Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket contacts the seat of the filter mounting.
S05319
Author:
Date:
1648
LU–3
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
(e)
3.
(a)
SST
3/4
Turn
(b)
–
Using SST, give it an additional 3/4 turn to seat the filter.
SST 09228–06501
FILL WITH ENGINE OIL
Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Fill with new engine oil.
Capacity:
Drain and refill
S05320
Dry fill
(c)
4.
5.
OIL AND FILTER
w/ Oil filter change
w/o Oil filter change
3.6 liters (3.8 US qts, 3.2 lmp. qts)
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 lmp. qts)
w/ Oil cooler
w/o Oil cooler
4.3 liters (4.5 US qts, 3.8 lmp. qts)
4.2 liters (4.4 US qts, 3.7 lmp. qts)
Reinstall the oil filler cap.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR OIL LEAKS
RECHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1649
LU–4
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
OIL PUMP
LU03J–03
COMPONENTS
64 (650, 47)
64 (650, 47)
Engine Moving Control Rod
52 (530, 38)
Ground Strap Connector
No.2 RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Generator Drive Belt
RH Front Fender Apron Seal
PS Pump Drive Belt
Exhaust Pipe Bracket
Oil Pan Insulator
No.2 Rear End Plate
LH Stiffener Plate
No.2 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
Gasket
(TMMK Made)
(TMC Made)
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Bracket
Front Exhaust Pipe
62 (630, 46)
Stay
Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
S05595
Author:
Date:
1650
LU–5
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
Generator Wire
Generator Connector
Generator
* Gasket
Wire
Clamp
Wire
Clamp
Timing Belt
No.2 Timing Belt Cover
No.1 Timing Belt Cover
Timing Belt Guide
Crankshaft Pulley
* Gasket
High–Tension Cord
Spark Plug
18 (180, 13)
108 (1,100, 80)
Clamp
Clamp
Wire Clamp
No.1 Idler Pulley
42 (425, 31)
Gasket
No.2 Idler Pulley
Tension Spring
42 (425, 31)
Oil Pump Pulley
24 (245, 18)
Oil Pump
Gasket
x 10
Crankshaft
Timing Pulley
8.8 (90, 78 in.·lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
Oil Strainer
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Oil Pan
x 17
Gasket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
* Replace only if damaged
Drain Plug
Non–reusable part
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
B06345
Author:
Date:
1651
LU–6
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
Oil Pump Body
Driven Rotor
Drive Rotor
8.8 (90, 7.8 in.·lbf)
O–Ring
Relief Valve
Crankshaft
Front Oil Seal
Spring
Oil Pump Body Cover
Retainer
Snap Ring
Oil Pump
Oil Seal
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z19079
Author:
Date:
1652
LU–7
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU03K–03
REMOVAL
HINT:
When repairing the oil pump, the oil pan and strainer should be
removed and cleaned.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
2.
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EM–69)
3.
REMOVE NO.2 EXHAUST MANIFOLD STAY AND LH
STIFFENER PLATE (See page EM–69)
4.
REMOVE EXHAUST PIPE BRACKET, OIL PAN INSULATOR AND NO.2 REAR END PLATE
(See page EM–69)
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE OIL PAN
Remove the oil dipstick.
Remove the 17 bolts and 2 nuts.
S05311
(c)
Insert the blade of SST between the cylinder block and oil
pan, and cut off applied sealer and remove the oil pan.
SST 09032–00100
NOTICE:
Do not use SST for the oil pump body side and rear oil
seal retainer.
Be careful not to damage the oil pan flange.
SST
SST
S05952
6.
REMOVE OIL STRAINER
Remove the bolt, 2 nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
7.
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page EM–17)
8.
REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
9.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(See page EM–17)
10. REMOVE OIL PUMP PULLEY (See page EM–17)
S05928
Author:
Date:
1653
LU–8
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
11. REMOVE OIL PUMP
Remove the 12 bolts, oil pump and gasket.
S05607
Author:
Date:
1654
LU–9
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU03L–03
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE RELIEF VALVE
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Remove the retainer, spring and relief valve.
S01168
2.
REMOVE DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
Remove the 2 bolts, pump body cover, O–ring, the drive and
driven rotors.
S01169
Author:
Date:
1655
LU–10
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU03M–03
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT RELIEF VALVE
Coat the valve with engine oil and check that it falls smoothly
into the valve hole by its own weight.
If it doesn’t, replace the relief valve. If necessary, replace the oil
pump assembly.
S01170
2.
(a)
S01483
INSPECT DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
Inspect the rotors for body clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the driven rotor and body.
Standard body clearance:
0.10 – 0.16 mm (0.0039 – 0.0063 in.)
Maximum body clearance: 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than maximum, replace the rotors as a set. If necessary, replace the oil pump assembly.
(b)
Inspect the rotors for tip clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between
the drive and driven rotor tips.
Standard tip clearance:
0.04 – 0.16 mm (0.0016 – 0.0063 in.)
Maximum tip clearance: 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than maximum, replace the rotors
as a set.
S01484
Author:
Date:
1656
LU–11
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU03N–03
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
REPLACE OIL PUMP OIL SEAL
Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
(b)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its surface is flush with the oil pump cover edge.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00350),
09950–70010 (09951–07100)
Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
(See page EM–104)
S01162
(c)
2.
SST
S01485
Author:
Date:
1657
LU–12
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU0FP–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
Mark
(b)
INSTALL DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
Place the drive and driven rotors into pump body with the
mark on the driven rotor facing the pump body side.
Install a new O–ring to the oil pump body.
Downward
S01487
(c)
Install the oil pump body cover with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.8 N·m (90 kgf·cm, 78 in.·lbf)
2.
(a)
INSTALL RELIEF VALVE
Insert the relief valve, spring and retainer into the oil pump
body hole.
Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
S01169
(b)
S01168
Author:
Date:
1658
LU–13
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU03P–03
A
A
INSTALLATION
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
B
B
Z19249
1.
INSTALL OIL PUMP
Install a new gasket and the oil pump with the 12 bolts. Uniformity tighten the bolts in several passes.
Torque: 8.8 N·m (90 kgf·cm, 78 in.·lbf)
HINT:
Each bolt length is indicated in the illustration.
Bolt length:
25 mm (0.98 in.) for A
35 mm (1.38 in.) for B
2.
INSTALL OIL PUMP PULLEY (See page EM–23)
3.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT TIMING PULLEY
(See page EM–23)
4.
INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY (See page EM–23)
5.
INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page EM–23)
6.
INSTALL OIL STRAINER
Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
S05928
7.
(a)
Seal Width
3 – 5 mm
B
A
C
A
B
C
5 mm (0.20 in.)
LU0420
INSTALL OIL PAN
Remove any old seal packing (FIPG) material and be
careful not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the
oil pan and cylinder block.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all
the old packing (FIPG) material from the gasket surfaces and sealing groove.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surface.
NOTICE:
Do not use a solvent which will affect the painted surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the oil pan shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 3 – 5 mm (0.12
– 0.20 in.) opening.
Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be removed
and reapplied.
Author:
Date:
1659
LU–14
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
(c)
(d)
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall the cap.
Install the oil pan with the 17 bolts and 2 nuts. Uniformly
tighten the bolts and nuts in several passes.
Install the dipstick.
INSTALL NO.2 REAR END PLATE, OIL PAN INSULATOR AND EXHAUST PIPE BRACKET
(See page EM–75)
INSTALL LH STIFFENER PLATE AND NO.2 EXHAUST
MANIFOLD STAY (See page EM–23)
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(See page EM–75)
FILL WITH ENGINE OIL
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR OIL LEAKS
RECHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1660
LU–15
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL COOLER
OIL COOLER
LU03Q–03
COMPONENTS
Water Bypass Hose
Oil Filter
Union Bolt
78.5 (800, 58)
Oil Cooler
O–Ring
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
S05996
Author:
Date:
1661
LU–16
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL COOLER
LU03R–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
REMOVE OIL FILTER (See page LU–2)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE OIL COOLER
Disconnect the 2 water bypass hoses from the oil cooler.
Remove the union bolt and plate washer.
Remove the nut and oil cooler.
Remove the O–ring from the oil cooler.
S05613
Author:
Date:
1662
LU–17
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL COOLER
LU03S–03
INSPECTION
INSPECT OIL COOLER
Check the oil cooler for damage or clogging.
If necessary, replace the oil cooler.
S05929
Author:
Date:
1663
LU–18
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
–
OIL COOLER
LU03T–03
INSTALLATION
New
O–Ring
1.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL OIL COOLER
Clean the oil cooler contact surface on the oil cooler
mounting.
Install a new O–ring to the oil cooler.
S05930
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
S05613
(g)
2.
3.
4.
5.
Temporarily install the oil cooler with the nut.
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under
the head of the union bolt.
Install the plate washer and union bolt.
Torque: 78.5 N·m (800 kgf·cm, 58 ft·lbf)
Tighten the nut.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in.·lbf)
Connect the 2 water bypass hoses to the oil cooler.
INSTALL OIL FILTER (See page LU–2)
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1664
LU–1
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL AND FILTER
OIL AND FILTER
Recommended Viscosity (SAE):
LU0FR–01
INSPECTION
10W–30
5W–30 PREFERRED
°F –20
°C –29
0
–18
20
–7
40
4
60
16
80
27
100
38
TEMPERATURE RANGE ANTICIPATED BEFORE NEXT OIL CHANGE
B00319
SST
1.
CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, discoloring or thinning.
If the quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
API grade SJ, Energy–Conserving or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
SAE 5W – 30 is the best choice for your vehicle, for
good fuel economy, and good starting in cold weather.
2.
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
After warm up the engine and then 5 minutes after the engine
stop, oil level should be between the low level and full level
marks on the dipstick.
If low, check for leakage and add oil up to the full level mark.
NOTICE:
Do not fill with engine oil above the full level mark.
3.
REMOVE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH, AND INSTALL
OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
(a) Using SST, remove the oil pressure switch.
SST 09816–30010
P25173
(b)
Oil Pressure Gauge
Install the oil pressure gauge.
P25171
4.
WARM UP ENGINE
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
5.
CHECK OIL PRESSURE
Oil pressure:
At idle
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi) or more
At 3,000 rpm
294 – 539 kPa (3.0 – 5.5 kgf/cm2, 43 – 78 psi)
Author:
Date:
1665
LU–2
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
6.
Adhesive
(a)
(b)
(c)
P12478
7.
–
OIL AND FILTER
REMOVE OIL PRESSURE GAUGE AND REINSTALL
OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Remove the oil pressure gauge.
Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure switch.
Adhesive: Part No. 08833–00080, THREE BOND 1344,
LOCTITE 242 or equivalent
Using SST, install the oil pressure switch.
SST 09816–30010
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
Author:
Date:
1666
LU–3
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL AND FILTER
LU026–03
REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will
result in the removal of natural fats from the skin,
leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially harmful
contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
Exercise caution in order to minimize the length and
frequency of contact of your skin to used oil. Wear
protective clothing and gloves. Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or use water–less hand
cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use
gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
In order to preserve the environment, used oil and
used oil filter must be disposed of only at designated
disposal sites.
1.
(a)
(b)
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
Remove the oil filler cap.
Remove the oil drain plug, and drain the oil into a container.
2.
(a)
REPLACE OIL FILTER
Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228–07501
Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil filter.
P12486
SST
(b)
(c)
P12580
(d)
SST
(e)
Lightly screw the oil filter into place, and tighten it until the
gasket contacts the seat.
Using SST, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn.
SST 09228–07501
Additional
3/4 Turn
P12582
Author:
Date:
1667
LU–4
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
3.
(a)
(b)
–
OIL AND FILTER
REFILL WITH ENGINE OIL
Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 45 N·m (460 kgf·cm, 33 ft·lbf)
Fill with fresh engine oil.
Capacity:
Drain and refill
w/ Oilfilter change
w/o Oilfilter change
Dry fill
(c)
4.
5.
4.7 liters (5.0 US qts, 4.1 lmp. qts)
4.5 liters (4.8 US qts, 4.0 lmp. qts)
5.2 liters (5.5 US qts, 4.6 lmp. qts)
Install the oil filler cap.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR OIL LEAKS
RECHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1668
LU–5
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
OIL PUMP
LU027–04
COMPONENTS
RH Fender Apron Seal
Engine Moving
Control Rod
64 (650, 47)
Generator Drive
Belt
32 (320, 23)
64 (650, 47)
RH Engine Mounting Stay
Ground Strap
No.2 RH Engine Mounting
Bracket
PS Pump Drive Belt
PS Pump Drive Belt
Adjusting Strut
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Stay (M/T)
Radiator Reservoir Hose
A/C Compressor
Connector
A/C Compressor
Generator Drive Belt
Adjusting Bar Bracket
Bracket
21 (210, 15)
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Gasket
Front Exhaust Pipe
62 (630, 46)
Bracket
Stay
33 (330, 24)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
33 (330, 24)
62 (630, 46)
B06398
Author:
Date:
1669
LU–6
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
Timing Belt
Gasket
No.2 Timing Belt Cover
RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Timing Belt Guide
28 (290, 21)
No.2 Generator
Bracket
No.1 Timing Belt Cover
Gasket
Crankshaft
Pulley
Engine Wire
Protector
RH Camshaft Timing Pulley
No.2 Idler Pulley
215 (2,200, 159)
125 (1,300, 94)
*88 (900, 65)
43 (440, 32)
LH Camshaft
Timing Pulley
125 (1,300, 94)
No.1 Idler Pulley
Plate Washer
Dust Boot
34 (350, 25)
Timing Belt Plate
Crankshaft
Timing Pulley
27 (280, 20)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Precoated part
Timing Belt Tensioner
* For use with SST
B06384
Author:
Date:
1670
LU–7
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
No.3 Timing Belt Cover
Gasket
Collar
Bushing
8.5 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
x6
O–Ring
Engine Wire
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
x6
A/C Compressor
Housing Bracket
Crankshaft Position
Sensor
Oil Pump
Oil Pan Baffle Plate
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
Connector
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
x9
(A/T only)
x 17 or 19
No.1 Oil Pan
(A/T only)
10 mm Head 8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
12 mm Head 19.5 (200, 14)
or 0
or 0
Flywheel Housing
Under Cover
Exhaust Pipe
Support Stay
10 mm Head 8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
12 mm Head 19.5 (200, 14)
14 mm Head 37.2 (380, 27)
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
Oil Strainer
Gasket
No.2 Oil Pan
Drain Plug
45 (460, 33)
x 10
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
B04401
Author:
Date:
1671
LU–8
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
Oil Pump Body Cover
Drive Rotor
Oil Pump Body
Driven Rotor
x9
Crankshaft Front
Oil Seal
Relief Valve
Spring
Gasket
Plug
36.8 (375, 27)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B01016
Author:
Date:
1672
LU–9
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU028–03
REMOVAL
HINT:
When repairing the oil pump, the oil pan and strainer should be
removed and cleaned.
1.
REMOVE RH FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
3.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
4.
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EM–32)
5.
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE BRACKET FROM
NO.1 OIL PAN
6.
REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
(See page CH–6)
7.
DISCONNECT A/C COMPRESSOR FROM ENGINE
(See page AC–41)
8.
Pivot
Bolt
Adjusting
Strut
Adjusting Bolt
(a)
(b)
9.
10.
11.
P18778
REMOVE PS PUMP DRIVE BELT AND ADJUSTING
STRUT
Loosen the pivot and adjusting bolts, and remove the
drive belt.
Remove the bolt, nut and adjusting strut.
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page EM–15)
REMOVE TIMING PULLEYS (See page EM–15)
REMOVE NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
(See page EM–32)
12.
REMOVE A/C COMPRESSOR HOUSING
BRACKET
Remove the 3 bolts and housing bracket.
B01015
13.
(a)
REMOVE NO.2 OIL PAN
Remove the 10 bolts and 2 nuts.
P18801
Author:
Date:
1673
LU–10
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
(b)
SST
SST
Insert the blade of SST between the No.1 and No.2 oil
pans, and cut off applied sealer and remove the No.1 oil
pan.
SST 09032–00100
NOTICE:
Be careful not to the damage the No.2 oil pan contact
surface of the No.1 oil pan.
Be careful not to damage the No.2 oil pan flange.
P12716
14. REMOVE OIL STRAINER
Remove the bolt, 2 nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
P18802
15.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NO.1 OIL PAN
Remove the 2 bolts, exhaust pipe support stay and flywheel housing under cover.
Remove the 19 bolts (or 17 bolts and 2 nuts).
B04136
(c)
Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pan by prying the portions between the cylinder block and oil pan.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of the cylinder block and oil pan.
16. REMOVE BAFFLE PLATE FROM NO.1 OIL PAN
17. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
B04137
18.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Pry
REMOVE OIL PUMP
Remove the 9 bolts.
Remove the oil pump by prying a screwdriver between the
oil pump and main bearing cap.
Remove the O–ring.
P20050
Author:
Date:
1674
LU–11
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU029–03
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE RELIEF VALVE
Remove the plug, gasket, spring and relief valve.
P12680
2.
REMOVE DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
Remove the 9 screws, pump body cover, drive and driven rotors.
P12681
Author:
Date:
1675
LU–12
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU02A–03
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT RELIEF VALVE
Coat the valve with engine oil and check that it falls smoothly
into the valve hole by its own weight.
If it does not, replace the relief valve. If necessary, replace the
oil pump assembly.
P12419
2.
PLACE DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS INTO OIL PUMP
BODY
Place the drive and driven rotors into the oil pump body with the
mark facing upward.
Mark
P12807
3.
INSPECT ROTOR SIDE CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge and precision straight edge, measure the
clearance between the rotors and precision straight edge.
Standard side clearance:
0.030 – 0.090 mm (0.0012 – 0.0035 in.)
Maximum side clearance: 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
If the side clearance is greater than maximum, replace the rotors as a set. If necessary, replace the oil pump assembly.
P12597
4.
INSPECT ROTOR TIP CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the drive
and driven rotor tips.
Standard tip clearance:
0.110 – 0.240 mm (0.0043 – 0.0094 in.)
Maximum tip clearance: 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than maximum, replace the rotors
as a set.
P12593
5.
INSPECT ROTOR BODY CLEARANCE
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the driven rotor and body.
Standard body clearance:
0.100 – 0.175 mm (0.0039 – 0.0069 in.)
Maximum body clearance: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than maximum, replace the rotors as a set. If necessary, replace the oil pump assembly.
P12592
Author:
Date:
1676
LU–13
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU02B–03
REPLACEMENT
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT FRONT OIL SEAL
HINT:
There are 2 methods ((a) and (b)) to replace the oil seal which
are as follows:
(a)
If the oil pump is removed from the cylinder block.
(1) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
P12413
(2)
Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until
its surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09223–00010
(3) Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
SST
P12392
(b)
If the oil pump is installed to the cylinder block.
(1) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(2) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape the screwdriver tip.
Cut Position
P12475
(3)
(4)
Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
SST 09223–00010
SST
P12473
Author:
Date:
1677
LU–14
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU02C–03
REASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
Mark
P12807
INSTALL DRIVE AND DRIVEN ROTORS
Place the drive and driven rotors into pump body with the
marks facing the pump body cover side.
(b) Install the pump body cover with the 9 screws.
2.
INSTALL RELIEF VALVE
Insert the relief valve and spring into the pump body hole, and
install the plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 36.8 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 37 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1678
LU–15
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
–
OIL PUMP
LU02D–03
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
INSTALL OIL PUMP
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the oil pump
and cylinder block.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all
the old packing (FIPG) material from the gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
(b)
Apply seal packing to the oil pump as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 2 – 3 mm (0.08
– 0.12 in.) opening.
B
A
HINT:
Avoid applying an excessive amount to the surface.
Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be removed
and reapplied.
Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall cap.
C
A
B
Seal Width
2 – 3 mm
C
P12969
(c)
Place a new O–ring on the cylinder block.
New O–Ring
P18779
Author:
Date:
1679
LU–16
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
(d)
(e)
P12694
2.
3.
4.
(a)
–
OIL PUMP
Engage the spline teeth of the oil pump drive gear with the
large teeth of the crankshaft, and slide the oil pump on the
crankshaft.
Install the oil pump with the 9 bolts. Uniformly tighten the
bolts in several passes.
Torque:
10 mm head: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
12 mm head: 19.5 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSTALL BAFFLE PLATE TO NO.1 OIL PAN
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
INSTALL NO.1 OIL PAN
Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surfaces of the oil pan,
oil pump and cylinder block.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all
the old packing (FIPG) material from the gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
Author:
Date:
1680
LU–17
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
(b)
Type A
Region ”Y”
Region ”X”
B
Type B A
Region ”X”
C
Region ”Y”
C
A
A
Seal Width
Type A: 4 – 5 mm
Type B: 3 – 4 mm
B
C
B04402
–
OIL PUMP
Apply seal packing to the oil pan as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Region ”X” is at the outer side of the bolt hole.
Region ”Y” is at the inner side of the bolt hole.
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 4 – 5 mm (0.16
– 0.20 in.) (Type A) or 3 – 4 mm (0.12 – 0.16 in.)
(Type B) opening.
HINT:
Avoid applying an excessive amount to the surface.
Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be removed
and reapplied.
Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall cap.
(c) Install the oil pan with the 19 bolts (or 17 bolts and 2 nuts).
Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts in several passes.
Torque:
10 mm head: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
12 mm head: 19.5 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
14 mm head: 37.2 N·m (380 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(d) Install the flywheel housing under cover and exhaust pipe
support stay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
5.
INSTALL OIL STRAINER
Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
6.
INSTALL NO.2 OIL PAN
(a) Remove any old packing (FIPG) material and be careful
not to drop any oil on the contact surface of the No.1 and
No.2 oil pans.
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all
the old packing (FIPG) material from the gasket surfaces and sealing grooves.
Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the
loose material.
Using a non–residue solvent, clean both sealing
surfaces.
NOTICE:
Do not use a solvent which will affect the painted surfaces.
Author:
Date:
1681
LU–18
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
(b)
A
B
A
Seal Width
4 – 5 mm
B
P12568
–
OIL PUMP
Apply seal packing to the No.2 oil pan as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Part No. 08826–00080 or equivalent
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 4 – 5 mm (0.16
– 0.20 in.) opening.
HINT:
Avoid applying an excessive amount to the surface.
Parts must be assembled within 3 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be removed
and reapplied.
Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall cap.
(c) Install the No.2 oil pan with the 10 bolts and 2 nuts. Uniformly tighten the bolts and nuts in several passes.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
7.
INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR HOUSING BRACKET
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
8.
INSTALL NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
(See page EM–21)
9.
INSTALL TIMING PULLEYS (See page EM–21)
10. INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page EM–21)
11. INSTALL ADJUSTING STRUT AND PS PUMP DRIVE
BELT
(a) Temporarily install the adjusting strut with the bolt and the
nut.
(b) Install the drive belt with the pivot and adjusting bolts.
Torque: 43.1 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
(c) Tighten the nut.
Torque: 43.1 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
12. INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR (See page AC–47)
13. INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
(See page CH–16)
14. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE BRACKET TO
NO.1 OIL PAN
Torque: 21 N·m (210 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
15. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EM–76)
16. REMOVE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
17. REMOVE RH FRONT WHEEL
18. FILL ENGINE WITH OIL
19. START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
20. RECHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1682
RS–1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SRS AIRBAG
SRS AIRBAG
RS01Y–22
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
The CAMRY is equipped with SRS, which comprises a driver airbag, front passenger airbag,
and side airbag. Failure to carry out service operations in the correct sequence could cause
the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident. Further, if a mistake is made in servicing the SRS, it is possible that the SRS may fail to operate
when required. Before performing servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the following items carefully, then follow the correct procedures described in the repair manual.
Malfunction symptoms of the SRS are difficult to confirm, so the DTCs become the most important source of information when troubleshooting. When troubleshooting the SRS, always inspect the DTCs before disconnecting the battery.
Even in cases of a minor collision where the SRS does not deploy, the steering wheel pad, front
passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly (TMC made and TMMK made), airbag sensor
assembly, front airbag sensor and side airbag sensor assembly should be inspected.
(See page RS–16, RS–29, RS–41, RS–54, RS–60, RS–65 and RS–70)
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
Never disassemble and repair the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, side
airbag assembly, airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensor or side airbag sensor assembly
in order to reuse it.
If the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly, airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensor or side airbag sensor assembly has been dropped, or if there
are cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or connector, replace them with new
ones.
Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 kΩ/V minimum) for troubleshooting the system’s
electrical circuits.
Information labels are attached to the periphery of the SRS components. Follow the instructions on the notices.
After work on the SRS is completed, perform the SRS warning light check (See page DI–626).
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precaution in the
IN section.
CAUTION:
Work must be started 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and
the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
(The SRS is equipped with a back–up power source so that if work is started within 90 seconds
from disconnecting the negative (–) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may be deployed.)
When the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the memory of the clock
and audio system will be canceled. So before starting work, make a record of the contents memorized in the audio memory system. When work is finished, reset the audio systems as they
were before and adjust the clock. To avoid erasing the memory in each memory system, never
use a back– up power supply from outside the vehicle.
Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor if shocks are likely to be applied to the sensor during
repairs.
Do not expose the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, side airbag assembly,
airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensor or side airbag sensor assembly directly to hot air
or flames.
Author:
Date:
2146
RS–2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SRS AIRBAG
RS0ET–01
OPERATION
1.
STEERING WHEEL PAD (with AIRBAG)
The inflater and bag of the SRS are stored in the steering wheel
pad and cannot be disassembled. The inflater contains a squib,
igniter charge, gas generant, etc., and inflates the bag when
instructed by the airbag sensor assembly.
W03512
2.
SPIRAL CABLE (in COMBINATION SWITCH)
A spiral cable is used as an electrical joint from the vehicle body
side to the steering wheel.
Spiral Cable
R09725
3.
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
The inflater and bag of the SRS are stored in the front passenger airbag assembly and cannot be disassembled. The inflater
contains a squib, igniter charge and gas generant, etc., and inflates the bag when instructed by the airbag sensor assembly.
W03511
4.
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
The inflater and bag of the SRS side airbag are stored in the
side airbag assembly and cannot be disassembled. The inflater
contains a squib, igniter charge and gas generant, etc., and inflates the bag when instructed by the side airbag sensor assembly.
H01347
5.
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
The seat belt pretensioner system is a component of the front
seat outer belt. The pretensioner contains a squib, gas generant, wire, piston, etc., and operates in the event of a frontal collision.
H02610
Author:
Date:
2147
RS–3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SRS AIRBAG
6.
SRS WARNING LIGHT
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter. It
goes on to alert the driver of trouble in the system when a malfunction is detected in the airbag sensor assembly self–diagnosis. In normal operation conditions when the ignition switch is
turned to the ACC or ON position, the light goes on for about 6
seconds and then goes off.
H02309
7.
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
The airbag sensor assembly is mounted on the floor inside the
lower center finish panel. The airbag sensor assembly consists
of an airbag sensor, safing sensor, diagnosis circuit, ignition
control and drive circuit, etc. It receives signals from the airbag
sensor and judges whether the SRS must be activated or not.
H02266
8.
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
A front airbag sensor is mounted inside each of the side members. The sensor unit is a mechanical type. When the sensor
detects deceleration force above a predetermined limit, contact
is made in the sensor, sending a signal to the airbag sensor assembly. The sensor cannot be disassembled.
H08235
9.
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
The side airbag sensor assembly is mounted in the LH and RH
center pillars. The side airbag sensor assembly consists of a lateral deceleration sensor, safing sensor and diagnosis circuit,
etc. It receives signals to the airbag sensor assembly to judge
from the side airbag sensors whether the SRS side airbag must
be activated or not.
H03284
Author:
Date:
2148
RS–4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
10.
–
SRS AIRBAG
TMC made:
SRS CONNECTORS
8
Side Airbag Assembly (RH)
(Squib)
9
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (RH)
10
Side Airbag Sensor (RH)
11
12
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
4
2
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly (Squib)
Spiral Cable 7
5
1
3
Steering Wheel
Pad (Squib)
6
No.1 J/B
13
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
14
Side Airbag Sensor (LH)
15
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (LH)
16
Side Airbag Assembly (LH)
(Squib)
H08316
No.
Item
Application
(1)
Terminal Twin–Lock Mechanism
Connectors 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16
(2)
Airbag Activation Prevention Mechanism
Connectors 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7, 8, 9, 15, 16
(3)
Electrical Connection Check Mechanism
Connectors 1, 2, 3
(4)
Connector Twin–Lock Mechanism
Connectors 5, 6, 7
Author:
Date:
2149
RS–5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
11.
–
SRS AIRBAG
TMMK made:
SRS CONNECTORS
18
8
Side Airbag Assembly (RH)
(Squib)
9
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (RH)
10
Side Airbag Sensor (RH)
11
12
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
4
Front Passenger Airbag
Assembly (Squib)
Spiral Cable
7
2
Airbag Sensor
Assembly
5
1
3
Steering Wheel
Pad (Squib)
6
No.1 J / B
13
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
14
Side Airbag Sensor (LH)
15
17
Seat Belt
Pretensioner (LH)
16
Side Airbag Assembly (LH)
(Squib)
H08247
No.
Item
Application
(1)
Terminal Twin–Lock Mechanism
Connectors 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16,
17, 18
(2)
Airbag Activation Prevention Mechanism
Connectors 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7, 8, 9, 15, 16, 17, 18
(3)
Electrical Connection Check Mechanism
Connectors 1, 2, 3
(4)
Connector Twin–Lock Mechanism
Connectors 5, 6, 7
Author:
Date:
2150
RS–6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(a)
Housing
(2)
Female
Male
Z05953
SRS AIRBAG
All connectors in the SRS are colored in yellow to distinguish them from other connectors. Connectors having
special functions and specifically designed for the SRS
are used in the locations shown on the previous page to
ensure high reliability. These connectors use durable
gold–plated terminals.
(1)
Spacer
–
Terminal twin–lock mechanism
Each connector has a two–piece component consisting of a housing and a spacer. This design enables the terminal to be locked securely by two locking devices (the retainer and the lance) to prevent
terminals from coming out.
Airbag activation prevention mechanism
Each connector contains a short spring plate. When
the connector is disconnected, the short spring
plate automatically connects positive (+) terminal
and negative (–) terminal of the squib.
When Connector is Connected
When Connector is Disconnected
Short Spring Plate
Short Spring Plate
Contacting Male Terminal
Housing
Housing
Short Spring Plate ON
Terminal
Squib
Connectors
Squib
Short Spring Plate
Closed Circuit
Author:
Date:
R10587
2151
RS–7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SRS AIRBAG
HINT:
The type of connector is shown in the diagram on the previous
page.
(3)
SRS
Warning
Light
Disconnection
Detection
Pin
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Electrical connection check mechanism
This mechanism electrically checks that connectors
are connected correctly and completely. The electrical connection check mechanism is designed so
that the disconnection detection pin connects with
the diagnosis terminals when the connector housing lock is locked.
R12076
Half Connection
Complete Connection
Terminal for Diagnosis
Terminal for
Diagnosis
Disconnection Detection Pin
H01315
HINT:
The connectors shown in this illustration are connectors, ”1”, ”2”
and ”3” in step 10 and 11.
Author:
Date:
2152
RS–8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(4)
–
SRS AIRBAG
Connector twin–lock mechanism
With this mechanism connectors (male and female
connectors) are locked by 2 locking devices to increase the connection reliability. If the primary lock
is incomplete, ribs interfere and prevent the secondary lock.
Secondary Lock
Primary Lock Complete
(Secondary Lock Permitted)
Primary Lock Incomplete
(Secondary Lock Prevented)
(b)
Fig.1
Power Source
Safing
Sensor
Fig.2
Lock
Lock
Primary Lock
Squibs
Twin–Lock Completed
AB0089
When the vehicle is involved in a frontal collision in the
hatched area (Fig. 1) and the shock is larger than the predetermined level, the SRS is activated automatically. A
safing sensor is designed to go on at a smaller deceleration rate than the airbag sensor. As illustrated in Fig. 2,
ignition is caused when current flows to the squib, which
happens when a safing sensor and the deceleration sensor go on simultaneously. When a deceleration force acts
on the sensors, 2 squibs in the driver airbag and front passenger airbag ignite and generate gas. The gas discharging into the driver airbag and front passenger airbag rapidly increases the pressure inside the bags, breaking
open the steering wheel pad and instrument panel door.
Bag inflation then ends, and the bags deflate as the gas
is discharged through discharge holes at the bag’s rear or
side.
Deceleration
Sensor
Z14034
Author:
Date:
2153
RS–9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
12.
Outer
(a)
(b)
H01581
–
SRS AIRBAG
DISCONNECTION OF FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR AND
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR CONNECTOR
While holding both flank sides of the outer, slide the outer
to the direction shown by an arrow.
Lock of the connectors is released, then disconnect the
connectors.
HINT:
Make sure to hold both flank sides of the outer. If holding the top
and bottom sides, it will obstruct disconnection.
Lock of connector is released
Disconnection is completed
H01582
13.
CONNECTION OF FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR AND
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR CONNECTOR
(a) Align the male connector (of the side of sensor) and female connector in the same direction as shown in the illustration and fit in them without rubbing.
(b) As they are fitted in, the outer slides rearward. Press it until the outer returns to its original position again.
If fitting stops half way, connectors will separate.
(c) Make sure to insert until they are locked. After fitting in,
pull them slightly to check that they are locked. (When
locked, make sure that the outer returns to its original
position and sound at the time of fitting in can be heard.)
HINT:
Do not fit in while holding the outer.
When fitting in, the outer slides. Do not touch it.
Outer
Outer
H01583
Author:
Date:
2154
RS–10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
14.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Slider
–
SRS AIRBAG
DISCONNECTION OF SIDE AIRBAG CONNECTOR
Place a finger on the slider.
Slide the slider to release lock.
Disconnect the connector.
Slider
Disconnection is completed
H01584
Author:
Date:
2155
RS–11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
15.
(a)
(b)
–
SRS AIRBAG
CONNECTION OF SIDE AIRBAG CONNECTOR
Align a lock part of male connector and a slider of female
connector in the same direction as shown in the illustration, fit in them without rubbing.
Make sure to insert until they are locked. After fitting in pull
them slightly to check that they are locked. (When locked,
make sure that the outer returns to its original position and
sound at the time of fitting in can be heard.)
HINT:
As the slider slides, do not touch it.
Be careful not to deform the release board. If the release
board is deformed, replace it with a new one.
Slider
Slider
H01585
Author:
Date:
2156
RS–12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
16.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Slider
–
SRS AIRBAG
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR FRONT
PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Place a finger on the slider.
Slide the slider to release lock.
Disconnect the connector.
Slider
Disconnection is completed
H01586
Author:
Date:
2157
RS–13
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
17.
(a)
(b)
–
SRS AIRBAG
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Align a lock part of male connector and a slider of female
connector in the same direction as shown in the illustration, fit in them without rubbing.
Make sure to insert until they are locked. After fitting in pull
them slightly to check that they are locked. (When locked,
make sure that the outer returns to its original position and
sound at the time of fitting in can be heard.)
HINT:
As the slider slides, do not touch it.
Be careful not to deform the release board. If the release
board is deformed, replace it with a new one.
Slider
Slider
H01587
Author:
Date:
2158
RS–14
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
RS00Y–20
COMPONENTS
Column Upper Cover
Steering Wheel Lower
No.2 Cover
Steering Wheel
Spiral Cable
35 (360, 26)
Steering Wheel Lower
No.2 Cover
Steering Wheel Pad
Torx Screw
7.1 (72, 63 in.·lbf)
Column Lower Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H03294
Author:
Date:
2159
RS–15
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
RS00Z–14
REMOVAL
HINT:
For step 1 to 4, refer to page SR–11.
1.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL PAD
2.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL
3.
REMOVE UPPER AND LOWER COLUMN COVERS
4.
REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE
Author:
Date:
2160
RS–16
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
RS010–19
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
W03512
2.
(a)
(b)
W03513
Horn Button
Contact Plate
VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION
Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the steering wheel pad (with airbag) installed in the vehicle.
Check cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
steering wheel pad top surface and in the grooved portion.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
NOT DEPLOYED
Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the steering wheel pad (with airbag) removed from the vehicle.
Check cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration
on the steering wheel pad top surface and in the
grooved portion.
Check cuts and cracks in wire harnesses, and chipping in connectors.
Check the deformation of the horn button contact
plate on the steering wheel.
HINT:
If the horn button contact plate of the steering wheel is deformed, never repair it. Always replace the steering wheel
assembly with a new one.
W03521
Author:
Date:
2161
RS–17
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
There should be no interference between the steering
wheel pad and steering wheel, and the clearance should
be uniform all the way around when the new steering
wheel pad is installed on the steering wheel.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the steering wheel pad, see
page SR–11 and SR–16, and be sure to follow the correct
procedure.
W03651
3.
(a)
(b)
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
DEPLOYED
Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the steering wheel pad (with airbag) removed from the vehicle.
Check the deformation on the horn button contact
plate of the steering wheel.
Check the damage on the spiral cable connector
and wire harness.
HINT:
If the horn button contact plate of the steering wheel is deformed, never repair it. Always replace the steering wheel
assembly with a new one.
There should be no interference between the steering
wheel pad and steering wheel, and the clearance should
be uniform all the way around when the new steering
wheel pad is installed on the steering wheel.
Author:
Date:
2162
RS–18
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
RS011–19
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping vehicle equipped with an SRS or disposing of
a steering wheel pad (with airbag), always first deploy the airbag in accordance with the procedure described below. If any
abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment, contact the
SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
When disposing of a steering wheel pad with an airbag
deployed in a collision, follow the same procedure given in step
1–(d) in ”DISPOSAL”.
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a steering wheel pad which has an
undeployed airbag.
The airbag produces a sizeable exploding sound
when it deploys, so perform the operation out–of–
doors and where it will not create a nuisance to
nearby residents.
SST
AB0152
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the operation in a place away from electrical noise.
SST 09082–00700
When deploying an airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the steering wheel pad.
The steering wheel pad is very hot when the airbag is
deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a steering wheel pad with the deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a steering wheel pad with
the deployed airbag.
Author:
Date:
2163
RS–19
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
1.
Battery
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT WHEN SCRAPPING VEHICLE
HINT:
Have a battery ready as the power source to deploy the airbag.
SST
AB0158
(a) Check functioning of the SST.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified SST:
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool.
SST 09082–00700
SST
AB0152
(1)
Battery
Connect the SST to the battery.
Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the battery negative (–) terminal.
HINT:
Do not connect the yellow connector which will be connected
with the supplemental restraint system.
SST
AB0158
(2)
SST
Check functioning of the SST.
Press the SST activation switch, and check that the
LED of the SST activation switch lights up.
CAUTION:
If the LED lights up when the activation switch is not being
pressed, SST malfunction is probable, so definitely do not
use the SST.
H01580
(b) Install the SST.
CAUTION:
Check that there is no looseness in the steering wheel and
steering wheel pad.
(1) Remove the steering column lower cover.
Remove the 3 screws and steering column lower
cover as shown in the illustration.
(2) Disconnect the airbag connector of the spiral cable.
W03515
Author:
Date:
2164
RS–20
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
(3)
Connect the SST connector to the airbag connector
of the spiral cable.
SST 09082–00700
SST
W03508
(4)
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
front of the vehicle.
Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
(5)
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(6) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the negative (–) terminal.
10 m (33 ft) or more
R13455
(c)
R06753
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Confirm that no one is inside the vehicle or within 10
m (33 ft) area around the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT:
The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED of the SST activation switch lights up.
(d) Dispose of steering wheel pad (with airbag).
CAUTION:
The steering wheel pad is very hot when the airbag is
deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a steering wheel pad with the deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a steering wheel pad with
the deployed airbag.
(1) When scrapping a vehicle, deploy the airbag and
scrap the vehicle with the steering wheel pad still
installed.
(2) When moving a vehicle for scrapping which has a
steering wheel pad with deployed airbag, use
gloves and safety glasses.
Author:
Date:
2165
RS–21
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
2.
DEPLOYMENT WHEN DISPOSING OF STEERING
WHEEL PAD ONLY
NOTICE:
When disposing of the steering wheel pad (with airbag) only, never use the customers vehicle to deploy
the airbag.
Be sure to follow the procedure given below when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Have a battery ready as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a) Remove the steering wheel pad.
(See page SR–11)
CAUTION:
When storing the steering wheel pad, keep the upper surface of the pad facing upward.
(b) Remove the steering wheel pad connector.
Remove the connector on the rear surface of the steering
wheel pad from the bracket.
Inflacter Cover
Connector
W03520
(c)
Wire Harness
Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
AB0163
Using a service–purpose wire harness, tie down the
steering wheel pad to the disc wheel.
Wire harness: Stripped wire harness section
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in2. or more).
CAUTION:
If a wire harness which is too thin or some other thing is
used to tie down the steering wheel pad, it may be snapped
by the shock when the airbag is deployed. This is highly
dangerous. Always use a wire harness for vehicle use
which is at least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in2).
HINT:
To calculate the square of the stripped wire harness section:
Square = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
(1)
L
M
H06693
Install the 2 bolts with washers in the 2 bolt holes in
the steering wheel pad.
Bolt:
L: 35.0 mm (1.387 in.)
M: 6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts by hand until the bolts become difficult to turn.
Do not tighten the bolts too much.
Author:
Date:
2166
RS–22
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(2)
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
Using 3 wire harnesses, wind the wire harness at
least 2 times each around the bolts installed on the
left and right sides of the steering wheel pad.
CAUTION:
Tightly wind the wire harness around the bolts so that
there is no slack.
If there is slack in the wire harness, the steering wheel
pad may come loose due to the shock when the airbag is deployed. This is highly dangerous.
2 Times or more
H06694
(3)
H06695
Battery
Face the upper surface of the steering wheel pad
upward. Separately tie the left and right sides of the
steering wheel pad to the disc wheel through the
hub nut holes. Position the steering wheel pad connector so that it hangs downward through a hub
hole in the disc wheel.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. It is very dangerous when looseness in the wire harness results in
the steering wheel pad coming free through the shock
from the airbag deploying.
Always tie down the steering wheel pad with the pad
side facing upward. It is very dangerous if the steering wheel pad is tied down with the metal surface facing upward as the wire harness will be cut by the
shock from the airbag deploying and the steering
wheel pad will be thrown into the air.
NOTICE:
The disc wheel will be marked by airbag deployment, so
when disposing of the airbag use a redundant disc wheel.
(d) Check functioning of the SST. (See step 1–(a))
SST 09082–00700
SST
AB0158
Author:
Date:
2167
RS–23
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SST
H06696
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
(e) Install the SST.
CAUTION:
Place the disc wheel on the level ground.
(1) Connect the connector of SST to the steering wheel
pad connector.
SST 09082–00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some slack for the SST wire harness inside the disc
wheel.
(2) Move the SST to at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
steering wheel pad tied down on the disc wheel.
(f)
y
y
x
Weight
H00401
Cover the steering wheel pad with a cardboard box or
tires.
Covering method using a cardboard box:
Cover the steering wheel pad with the cardboard
box and weight the cardboard box down in 4 places
with at least 190 N (20 kg, 44 lb).
Size of cardboard box:
Must exceed the following dimensions:
x= 460 mm (18.11 in.)
When dimension of the cardboard box exceeds the diameter of the disc wheel with tire to which the steering wheel pad is tied
x= 460 mm (18.11 in.) + width of tire
y= 650 mm (25.59 in.)
NOTICE:
If a cardboard box smaller than the specified size is used,
the cardboard box will be broken by the shock from the airbag deployment.
Covering method using tires:
Place at least 3 tires without disc wheel on top of the
disc wheel with tire to which the steering wheel pad
is tied.
Tire size: Must exceed the following dimensions–
Width: 185 mm (7.87 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Inner Diam.
Width
Tires
(3 or More)
R04211
Author:
Date:
2168
RS–24
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
CAUTION:
Do not use tires with disc wheels.
NOTICE:
The tires may be marked by the airbag deployment, so use
the redundant tires.
(g)
10 m (33 ft) or more
R13763
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the battery negative
(–) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within 10 m (33 ft) area around
the disc wheel which the steering wheel pad is tied
to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT:
The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED of the SST activation switch lights up.
AB0166
(h) Dispose of the steering wheel pad (with airbag).
CAUTION:
The steering wheel pad is very hot when the airbag is
deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a steering wheel pad with deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a steering wheel pad with
deployed airbag.
(1) Remove the steering wheel pad from the disc
wheel.
(2) Place the steering wheel pad in a vinyl bag, tie the
end tightly and dispose of it in the same way as other general parts disposal.
Author:
Date:
2169
RS–25
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
RS012–19
REPLACEMENT
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the steering wheel pad, steering wheel or spiral cable.
Case
Replacing part
If the airbag has been deployed.
Steering wheel pad
If the steering wheel pad has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
Steering wheel pad
If the spiral cable has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
Spiral cable
If the steering wheel pad has been found to be faulty during checking items.
(See page RS–16)
Steering wheel pad
If the steering wheel has been found to be faulty during checking items.
(See page RS–16)
Steering wheel
If the spiral cable has been found to be faulty during checking items.
(See page RS–16)
Spiral cable
If the steering wheel pad has been dropped.
Steering wheel pad
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the steering wheel pad, see page SR–11 and SR–16. Be sure to follow
the correct procedure.
Author:
Date:
2170
RS–26
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
STEERING WHEEL PAD AND SPIRAL CABLE
RS013–15
INSTALLATION
HINT:
For step 1 to 4, refer to page SR–16.
1.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE
2.
INSTALL UPPER AND LOWER COLUMN COVERS
3.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL
4.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL PAD
Author:
Date:
2171
RS–27
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS014–21
COMPONENTS
Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly
20 (205, 15)
Glove Compartment Box
Glove Compartment Door
Finish Plate
Cowl Side Trim RH
Front Door Scuff Plate RH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H08321
Author:
Date:
2172
RS–28
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS02P–03
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
If the wiring connector of the SRS is disconnected
and the ignition switch is in ON or ACC position, DTCs
will be recorded.
Never use the airbag parts from another vehicle.
When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
HINT:
For step 2 to 4, refer to page BO–75.
1.
(a)
H03287
DISCONNECT AIRBAG CONNECTOR
Remove the glove compartment door finish plate inside
the glove compartment box.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(b) Pull up the connector.
(c) Disconnect the front passenger airbag connector.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE
3.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM
4.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT BOX
5.
REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 bolts, 4 nuts and front passenger airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
Do not store the front passenger airbag assembly
with the airbag deployment side facing downward.
Never disassemble the front passenger airbag assembly.
W03509
Author:
Date:
2173
RS–29
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS02Q–03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
W03511
2.
(a)
(b)
W03517
VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION
Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the front passenger airbag assembly installed in the vehicle.
Check cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
front passenger airbag assembly and instrument panel.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
NOT DEPLOYED
Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the front passenger airbag assembly removed from the
vehicle.
Check cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration
on the front passenger airbag assembly.
Check cuts and cracks in wire harnesses, and for
chipping in connectors.
Check the deformation or cracks on the instrument
panel and instrument panel reinforcement.
HINT:
If the instrument panel or instrument panel reinforcement
is deformed or cracked, never repair it. Always replace it
with a new one.
W03510
There should be no interference between the instrument
panel and the front passenger airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the front passenger airbag
assembly, see page RS–28 and RS–38, and be sure to follow the correct procedure.
W03511
Author:
Date:
2174
RS–30
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
3.
(a)
(b)
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
DEPLOYED
Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the front passenger airbag assembly removed from the
vehicle.
Check the deformation or cracks on the instrument
panel and instrument panel reinforcement.
Check the damage on the connector and wire harness.
HINT:
If the instrument panel or instrument panel reinforcement is deformed or cracked, never repair it. Always replace it with a new
one.
Author:
Date:
2175
RS–31
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS05F–02
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping vehicle equipped with an SRS or disposing of
a front passenger airbag assembly, always first deploy the airbag in accordance with the procedure described below. If any
abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment, contact the
SERVICE DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
When disposing of a front passenger airbag assembly with an
airbag deployed in a collision, follow the same procedure given
in step 1–(e) in ”DISPOSAL”.
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a front passenger airbag assembly
which has an undeployed airbag.
The airbag produces a sizeable exploding sound
when it deploys, so perform the operation out–of–
doors and where it will not create a nuisance to
nearby residents.
SST
AB0152
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool). Perform the operation in a place away from electrical noise.
SST 09082–00700
When deploying an airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the front passenger airbag assembly.
The front passenger airbag assembly is very hot
when the airbag is deployed, so leave it alone for at
least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag assembly with deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front passenger airbag
assembly with deployed airbag.
Author:
Date:
2176
RS–32
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
1.
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT WHEN SCRAPPING VEHICLE
HINT:
Have a battery ready as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a) Check functioning of the SST. (See page RS–18)
SST 09082–00700
Battery
SST
AB0158
(b)
Disconnect the airbag connector.
(1) Remove the lower instrument cover inside the No.2
under cover.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(2) Pull up the connector.
(3) Disconnect the airbag connector.
H03287
(c)
Install the SST.
(1) Connect the connector of 2 SST to the front passenger airbag assembly connector.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00760
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
SST
H08317
(2)
Move the SST to at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
front of the vehicle.
Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
(3)
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(4) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the negative (–) terminal.
10 m (33 ft) or more
R13455
(d)
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within 10
m (33 ft) area around the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT:
The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED of the SST activation switch lights up.
H03286
Author:
Date:
2177
RS–33
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(e) Dispose of the front passenger airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
The front passenger airbag assembly is very hot
when the airbag is deployed, so leave it alone for at
least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag assembly with deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front passenger airbag
assembly with deployed airbag.
(1) When scrapping a vehicle, deploy the airbag and
scrap the vehicle with the front passenger airbag
assembly still installed.
(2) When moving a vehicle for scrapping which has a
front passenger airbag assembly with deployed airbag, use gloves and safety glasses.
2.
DEPLOYMENT WHEN DISPOSING OF FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY ONLY
NOTICE:
When disposing of the front passenger airbag assembly only, never use the customer’s vehicle to deploy
the airbag.
Be sure to follow the procedure given below when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Have a battery ready as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a)
W03619
Wire Harness
Diameter
Remove the front passenger airbag assembly.
(See page RS–28)
CAUTION:
When removing the front passenger airbag assembly,
work must be started 90 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the ”LOCK” position and the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
Store the front passenger airbag assembly with the
airbag deployment side facing upward.
(b) Using a service–purpose wire harness for the vehicle, tie
down the front passenger airbag assembly to the tire.
Wire harness: Stripped wire harness section
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
Stripped Wire Harness Section
AB0163
Author:
Date:
2178
RS–34
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
If the front passenger airbag assembly is tied down with
too thin wire harness, it may snap. This is highly dangerous. Always use a wire harness which is at least 1.25 mm2
(0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the square of the stripped wire harness section:
Square = 3.14 X (Diameter)2 divided by 4
(1)
L
M
W03519
Install the 2 bolts with washers in the 2 bolt holes in
the front passenger airbag assembly,
Bolt:
L: 35.0 mm (1.387 in.)
M: 6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts by hand until the bolts become difficult to turn.
Do not tighten the bolts too much.
(2) Using 3 wire harness, wind the wire harness at least
2 times each around the bolts installed on the front
passenger airbag assembly.
2 times or more
W03652
(3)
Width
Inner
Diam.
R08582
Position the front passenger airbag assembly inside the tire with the airbag deployment side facing
inside.
Tire size: Must exceed the following dimensions–
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. It is very dangerous if looseness in the wire harness results in the
front passenger airbag assembly coming free due to
the shock from the airbag deploying.
Always tie down the front passenger airbag assembly
with the airbag deployment side facing inside.
NOTICE:
The tire will be marked by the airbag deployment, so use a
redundant tire.
Author:
Date:
2179
RS–35
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(c)
Check functioning of the SST.
SST 09082–00700
(d)
Place tires.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire to which the front
passenger airbag assembly is tied.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire to which the front
passenger airbag assembly is tied. The top tire
should have the wheel installed.
Battery
SST
AB0158
Tires
(5 or more)
H04528
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harness.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. It is very dangerous if loose wire harness result in the tires coming free due
to the shock from the airbag deploying.
HINT:
Place the SST connector and wire harness inside tires. Provide
at least 1 m (3 ft) of slack for the wire harness.
R05403
(e)
Battery
SST
Front Passenger
Airbag Assembly
10 m (33 ft) or more
R09690
Install the SST.
Connect the connector of 2 SST to the front passenger
airbag assembly connector.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00760
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
(f)
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the battery negative
(–) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within 10 m (33 ft) area around
the tire which the front passenger airbag assembly
is tied to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT:
The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED of the SST activation switch lights up.
Author:
Date:
2180
RS–36
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
R09687
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(g) Dispose of the front passenger airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
The front passenger airbag assembly is very hot
when the airbag is deployed, so leave it alone for at
least 30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
passenger airbag assembly with deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front passenger airbag
assembly with deployed airbag.
(1) Remove the front passenger airbag assembly from
the tire.
(2) Place the front passenger airbag assembly in a vinyl bag, tie the end tightly and dispose of it in the
same way as other general parts.
Author:
Date:
2181
RS–37
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS018–17
REPLACEMENT
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the front passenger airbag assembly, instrument panel or instrument panel
reinforcement.
Case
Replacing part
If the airbag has been deployed.
Front passenger airbag assembly
If the front passenger airbag assembly has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
Front passenger airbag assembly
If the front passenger airbag assembly has been found to be faulty during
checking items. (See page RS–29)
Front passenger airbag assembly
If the instrument panel has been found to be faulty during checking items.
(See page RS–29)
Instrument panel
If the instrument panel reinforcement has been found to be faulty during
checking items. (See page RS–29)
Instrument panel reinforcement
If the front passenger airbag assembly has been dropped.
Front passenger airbag assembly
CAUTION:
For replacement of the front passenger airbag assembly, see page RS–28 and RS–38. Be sure to follow the correct procedure.
Author:
Date:
2182
RS–38
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS019–05
INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
Never use airbag parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
HINT:
For step 2 to 4, refer to page BO–81.
1.
(a)
W03509
INSTALL FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Install the front passenger airbag assembly with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 20 N·m (205 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
(b) Install the 4 nuts.
CAUTION:
Make sure that no foreign objects are trapped between the airbag bag and the module.
Do not damage the strap when installing the module.
NOTICE:
If the front passenger airbag assembly has been dropped,
or there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case or
connector, replace the front passenger airbag assembly
with a new one.
2.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT BOX
3.
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM
4.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
CONNECT AIRBAG CONNECTOR
Connect the airbag connector.
Put the connector on the glove compartment door finish
plate.
Install the glove compartment door finish plate to the
glove compartment box.
H03288
Author:
Date:
2183
RS–39
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
RS05G–02
COMPONENTS
Headrest
Headrest Support
Front Seatback Assembly
Front Seat Cushion
Inner Shield
Side Airbag
Assembly
Front Seat Cushion
Assembly
Front Seatback Cover
Hinge Cover
15 (150, 11)
18 (185, 13)
Seat Track Cover
37 (375, 27)
Front Seat Cushion Shield
Release Handle
Vartical Adjuster Knob
Power adjuster type:
Front Seat
Cushion Shield
Front Seat Cushion
Lower Shield
Front Seat Cushion
Lower Shield
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H08245
Author:
Date:
2184
RS–40
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
RS0EU–01
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
If the wiring connector of the SRS is disconnected
and the ignition switch is in ON or ACC position, DTCs
will be recorded.
Never use the airbag parts from another vehicle.
When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
1.
(a)
(b)
H02270
REMOVE FRONT SEAT
Remove the 2 seat track covers and 4 bolts.
Power adjuster type:
Disconnect the power seat and side airbag connectors.
(c) Manual adjuster type:
Disconnect the side airbag connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(d) Remove the front seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION LOWER SHIELD
3.
Manual adjuster type:
REMOVE RELEASE HANDLE
4.
Manual adjuster type:
REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTER KNOB
5.
Power adjuster type:
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
Disconnect the connector from the power seat switch.
6.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD
7.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION INNER SHIELD
8.
REMOVE HEADREST
9.
REMOVE HEADREST SUPPORT
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
Remove the 4 bolts.
Remove the hog rings.
Remove the seatback assembly.
H02259
Author:
Date:
2185
RS–41
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
RS05I–02
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION
Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the seatback assembly installed in the vehicle.
Check that there are no cuts or frayed seams and outside
of seatback cover.
Cross Section
H01608
2.
H08274
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
NOT DEPLOYED
(a) Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
(b) Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the seatback assembly removed from the vehicle.
Check cuts and cracks of the side airbag assembly.
Check cuts and cracks in wire harnesses, and chipping in connectors.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the seatback assembly, see
page RS–40 and RS–49. Be sure to follow the correct procedure.
3.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
DEPLOYED
(a) Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
(b) Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the seatback assembly removed from the vehicle.
Check the seatback installation part of the seat adjuster.
Check the damage to the connector and wire harness.
HINT:
If the seat adjuster is deformed, never repair it. Always replace
it with a new one.
Author:
Date:
2186
RS–42
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
RS05J–02
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping vehicles equipped with an SRS or disposing
of the side airbag assembly always first deploy the airbag in accordance with the procedure described below. If any abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment, contact the SERVICE
DEPT. of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
When disposing of a side airbag assembly with an airbag
deployed in a collision, follow the same procedure given in step
1–(e) in ”DISPOSAL”.
CAUTION:
Never dispose of a side airbag assembly which has
an undeployed airbag.
The airbag produces a sizeable exploding sound
when it deploys, so perform the operation out of
doors and where it will not create a nuisance to
nearby residents.
SST
AB0152
When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool), perform the operation in a place away from electrical noise.
SST 09082–00700
When deploying an airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft) away from the airbag assembly.
The side airbag assembly is very hot when the airbag
is deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30 minutes
after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling side
airbag assembly with the deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a side airbag assembly with
the deployed airbag.
Author:
Date:
2187
RS–43
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
1.
Battery
SST
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT WHEN SCRAPPING VEHICLE
HINT:
Have a battery ready as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a) Check functioning of the SST. (See page RS–18)
SST 09082–00700
AB0158
(b) Disconnect the side airbag connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
H01353
(c)
Battery
Install the SST.
(1) Connect the connector of 2 SST to the airbag connector.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00750
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
SST
H01354
(2)
Move the SST at least 10 m (33 ft) away from the
front of the vehicle.
Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
(3)
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(4) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the battery negative
(–) terminal.
10 m (33 ft) or more
R13455
(d)
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within 10
m (33 ft) area around the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT:
The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED of SST activation switch lights up.
H01326
Author:
Date:
2188
RS–44
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
(e) Dispose of side airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
The side airbag assembly is very hot when the airbag
is deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30 minutes
after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a side
airbag assembly with the deployed airbag.
Do not apply water, etc. to a side airbag assembly with
the deployed airbag.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
When scrapping a vehicle, deploy the airbag and scrap
the vehicle with the side airbag assembly still installed.
2.
DEPLOYMENT WHEN DISPOSING OF SIDE AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
When disposing of the side airbag assembly only,
never use the customer’s vehicle to deploy the airbag.
Be sure to follow the procedure given below when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Have a battery ready as the power source to deploy the airbag.
(a) Remove the seatback assembly.
(b) Remove the side airbag assembly from the seatback assembly.
CAUTION:
Store the side airbag assembly with the airbag deployment
side facing upward.
(c)
Wire Harness
Diameter
Stripped Wire Harness Section
AB0163
Using a service–purpose wire harness tie down the side
airbag assembly.
Wire harness: Stripped wire harness section
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in2 or more)
CAUTION:
If a wire harness which is too thin or some other thing is
used to tie down the side airbag assembly, it may be
snapped by the shock when the airbag is deployed. This is
highly dangerous. Always use a wire harness for vehicle
use which is at least 1.25 mm2 (0.0019 in2).
HINT:
To calculate the square of the stripped wire harness section:
Square = 3.14 x (Diameter)2 divided by 4
Author:
Date:
2189
RS–45
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
(1)
Install the 2 nuts to the side airbag assembly.
(2)
Wind the wire harness around the stud bolts of the
side airbag assembly as shown in the illustration.
H01333
H01334
(3)
Width
Inner
Diam.
H08326
Position the side airbag assembly inside the tire
with the airbag deployment direction facing inside.
Tire size : Must exceed the following dimensions:–
Width 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter 360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Make sure the wire harness is tight. It is very dangerous when a loose wire harness results in the side airbag assembly coming free due to the shock from the
airbag deploying.
Always tie down the side airbag assembly with the
airbag door facing inside.
NOTICE:
The tire will be marked by the airbag deployment, so when
disposing of the airbag use a redundant tire.
(d)
Check functioning of the SST. (See page RS–18)
SST 09082–00700
Battery
SST
AB0158
Author:
Date:
2190
RS–46
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(e)
Tires
(5 or More)
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
Place the tires.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire to which the side
airbag assembly is tied.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire to which the side
airbag assembly is tied. The top tire should have the
wheel installed.
H01336
(3) Tie the tires together with the 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harnesses are tight. It is very dangerous when loose wire harnesses result in the tires coming free due to the shock from the airbag deploying.
HINT:
Place the SST connector and wire harness inside tires. Secure
at least 1 m (3 ft) of slack for the wire harness.
R05403
(f)
Battery
(g)
SST
Side Airbag
Assembly
10 m (33 ft) or more
H01337
Install the SST.
Connect the connector of 2 SST to the side airbag assembly connector.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00750
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and the black clip to the battery negative
(–) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within 10 m (33 ft) area around
the tire which the side airbag assembly is tied to.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the airbag.
HINT:
The airbag deploys simultaneously as the LED of the SST activation switch lights up.
H00544
(h) Dispose of the side airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
The side airbag assembly is very hot when the airbag
is deployed, so leave it alone for at least 30 minutes
after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a side
airbag assembly with the deployed airbag.
Do not apply water etc. to a side airbag assembly with
the deployed airbag.
Author:
Date:
2191
RS–47
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
(1) Remove the side airbag assembly from the tire.
(2) Place the side airbag assembly in a vinyl bag, tie the
end tightly and dispose of it in the same way as other general parts disposal.
Author:
Date:
2192
RS–48
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
RS05K–02
REPLACEMENT
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the seatback assembly or seatback cover.
Case
Replacing part
If the side airbag has been deployed.
Seatback assembly
If the side airbag assembly has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
Seatback assembly
If the side airbag assembly has cuts during checking items.
(See page RS–41)
Seatback assembly
If the seatback cover has cuts and frayed seams during checking items.
(See page RS–41)
Seatback cover
If the side airbag assembly has been found to be faulty during checking
items. (See page RS–41)
Seatback assembly
If the seatback cover has been found to be faulty during checking items.
(See page RS–41)
Seatback cover
If the seatback assembly has been dropped.
Seatback assembly
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the seatback assembly, see page RS–40 and RS–49. Be sure to follow
the correct procedure.
Author:
Date:
2193
RS–49
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
RS0EV–01
INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
Never use airbag parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
A
B
H02259
1.
INSTALL SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the seatback assembly.
(b) Install new hog rings.
HINT:
Install the hog rings to prevent wrinkles as little as possible.
(c) Install the 4 bolts.
Torque:
Bolt A: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Bolt B: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION INNER SHIELD
3.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD
4.
Manual adjuster type:
INSTALL VERTICAL ADJUSTER KNOB
5.
Manual adjuster type:
INSTALL RELEASE HANDLE
6.
Power adjuster type:
CONNECT CONNECTOR
Connect the connector to the power seat switch.
7.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION LOWER SHIELD
8.
INSTALL HEADREST SUPPORT
9.
INSTALL HEADREST
10. INSTALL FRONT SEAT
(a) Slide the front seat to the most front position.
NOTICE:
Make sure that seat adjuster locks.
(b) Without holding the seat track handle, mount the seat to
the vehicle.
HINT:
If holding the seat track handle, the adjusted most front position
will slip off.
(c) Power adjuster type:
Connect the side airbag connector and power seat connector.
(d) Manual adjuster type:
Connect the side airbag connector.
(e) Tighten the bolts on the rear side temporarily, starting
from the bolt on the inner side tighten them completely.
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2194
RS–50
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(f)
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMC Made)
Slide the seat to the rearmost position to install the bolts
on the front side.
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2195
RS–51
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMMK Made)
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMMK Made)
RS05M–03
COMPONENTS
Headrest
Headrest Support
Seatback Assembly
Front Seat Cushion Assembly
Side Airbag
Assembly
Seat Truck Cover
37 (375, 27)
Front Seat Cushion Shield
Release Handle
Vartical Adjuster Knob
Power adjuster type:
Front Seat Cushion
Lower Shield
Front Seat
Cushion Shield
Front Seat Cushion
Lower Shield
Sub Wire Harness
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H08246
Author:
Date:
2196
RS–52
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMMK Made)
RS0EW–01
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
If the wiring connector of the SRS is disconnected
and the ignition switch is at ON or ACC position, DTCs
will be recorded.
Never use the airbag parts from another vehicle.
When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
1.
(a)
(b)
H02270
REMOVE FRONT SEAT
Remove the 2 seat track covers and 4 bolts.
Power adjuster type:
Disconnect the power seat and side airbag connectors.
(c) Manual adjuster type:
Disconnect the side airbag connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(d) Remove the front seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION LOWER SHIELD
3.
Manual adjuster type:
REMOVE RELEASE HANDLE
4.
Manual adjuster type:
REMOVE VERTICAL ADJUSTER KNOB
5.
Power adjuster type:
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
Disconnect the connector from the power seat switch.
6.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
Remove the 4 bolts.
Remove the hog rings.
Disconnect the side airbag connector of the side airbag
assembly side.
H02259
Author:
Date:
2197
RS–53
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(d)
(e)
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMMK Made)
Remove the side airbag sub wire harness after removing
clips.
Remove the seatback assembly.
H01871
Author:
Date:
2198
RS–54
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMMK Made)
RS05O–03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
VEHICLES NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION
Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the seatback assembly installed in the vehicle.
Check that there are no cuts or frayed in seams and outside of seatback cover.
Cross Section
H01608
2.
H08275
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN A COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
NOT DEPLOYED
(a) Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
(b) Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the seatback assembly removed from the vehicle.
Check cuts and cracks of the side airbag assembly.
Check cuts and cracks in wire harnesses, and chipping in connectors.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the seatback assembly, see
page RS–52 and RS–57. Be sure to follow the correct procedure.
3.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN A COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS
DEPLOYED
(a) Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
(b) Do a visual check which includes the following items with
the seatback assembly removed from the vehicle.
Check the seatback installation part of the seat adjuster.
Check the damage to the connector and wire harness.
HINT:
If the seat adjuster is deformed, never repair it. Always replace
it with a new one.
Author:
Date:
2199
RS–55
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMMK Made)
RS05P–02
DISPOSAL
(See page RS–42)
Author:
Date:
2200
RS–56
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMMK Made)
RS05Q–03
REPLACEMENT
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the seatback assembly or seat cover.
Case
Replacing part
If the side airbag has been deployed.
Seatback assembly
If the side airbag assembly has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
Seatback assembly
If the side airbag assembly has cuts during checking items.
(See page RS–54)
Seatback assembly
If the seatback cover has cuts and frayed seams during checking items.
(See page RS–54)
Seatback cover
If the side airbag assembly has been found to be faulty during checking
items. (See page RS–54)
Seatback assembly
If the seatback cover has been found to be faulty during checking items.
(See page RS–54)
Seatback cover
If the seatback assembly has been dropped.
Seatback assembly
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the seatback assembly, see page RS–52 and RS–57. Be sure to follow
the correct procedure.
Author:
Date:
2201
RS–57
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (TMMK Made)
RS0EX–01
INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
Never use airbag parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
1.
INSTALL SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the seatback assembly.
(b)
(c)
H01871
Securely fix the side airbag sub wire harness to the seat
cushion with clips.
Connect the side airbag connector of the side airbag assembly side.
Install new hog rings.
(d)
HINT:
Install the hog rings to prevent wrinkles as little as possible.
(e) Install the 4 bolts.
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD
3.
Manual adjuster type:
INSTALL VERTICAL ADJUSTER KNOB
4.
Manual adjuster type:
INSTALL RELEASE HANDLE
5.
Power adjuster type:
CONNECT CONNECTOR
Connect the connector to the power seat switch.
6.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION LOWER SHIELD
7.
INSTALL HEADREST SUPPORT
8.
INSTALL HEADREST
9.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT
(a) Slide the front seat to the most front position.
NOTICE:
Make sure that seat adjuster locks.
(b) Without holding the seat track handle, mount the seat to
the vehicle.
HINT:
If holding the seat track handle, the adjusted most front position
will slip off.
(c) Tighten the bolts on the rear side temporarily, starting
from the bolt on the inner side tighten them completely.
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(d) Slide the seat to the rearmost position to install the bolts
on the front side.
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(e) Power adjuster type:
Connect the side airbag connector and power seat connector.
(f)
Manual adjuster type:
Connect the side airbag connector.
Author:
Date:
2202
RS–58
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS01G–11
COMPONENTS
20 (205, 15)
Airbag Sensor Assembly
20 (205, 15)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H02269
Author:
Date:
2203
RS–59
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS0EY–01
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU and various
electrical devices unless absolutely necessary.
(If the IC terminals are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
REMOVE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the airbag sensor connectors.
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connectors with the sensor assembly
installed.
(b) Using a torx wrench, remove the 4 screws and airbag sensor assembly.
Torx wrench: T40 (Part No.09042–00020 or locally
manufactured tool)
LH side:
RH side:
H02267
H02268
H08322
Author:
Date:
2204
RS–60
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS05T–01
INSPECTION
1.
VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION
Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
2.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT DEPLOYED
Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
3.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS DEPLOYED
Replace the airbag sensor assembly. (See page RS–59)
Author:
Date:
2205
RS–61
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS01J–13
REPLACEMENT
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the airbag sensor assembly.
If the SRS has been deployed in a collision.
If the airbag sensor assembly has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
If the airbag sensor assembly has been dropped.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the airbag sensor assembly, see page RS–59 and RS–62. Be sure to
follow the correct procedure.
Author:
Date:
2206
RS–62
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS0EZ–01
INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
Never reuse the airbag sensor assembly involved in
a collision when the airbag has deployed.
Never repair a sensor in order to reuse it.
LH side:
RH side:
H02267
H02268
H08322
INSTALL AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a torx wrench, install the airbag sensor assembly
with 4 screws.
Torx wrench: T40 (Part No.09042–00020 or locally
manufactured tool)
Torque: 20 N·m (205 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the airbag sensor connectors.
NOTICE:
Connection of the connector is done after the sensor
assembly has been installed.
Make sure the sensor assembly is installed with the
specified torque.
If the sensor assembly has been dropped, or there are
cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or
connector, replace the sensor assembly with a new
one.
When installing the sensor assembly, take care that
the SRS wiring does not interfere with other parts and
is not pinched between other parts.
After installing , shake the sensor assembly to check
that there is no looseness.
Author:
Date:
2207
RS–63
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS01L–14
COMPONENTS
20 (205, 15)
20 (205, 15)
Front Airbag Sensor (LH)
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
20 (205, 15)
Turn Signal Light RH
Turn Signal Light LH
Head Light RH
Head Light LH
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H08233
Author:
Date:
2208
RS–64
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS0F0–01
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
If the wiring connector of the SRS is disconnected
with the ignition switch at ON or ACC position, DTCs
will be recorded.
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
Never reuse the sensor involved in a collision when
the SRS has deployed.
Never repair a sensor in order to reuse it.
1.
REMOVE HEAD LIGHT LH AND RH
(a) Remove the 2 clips and turn signal lights.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and head lights.
2.
LH:
REMOVE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connector with sensor assembly installed.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and front airbag sensor LH.
H08318
3.
RH:
REMOVE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connector with sensor assembly installed.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and front airbag sensor RH.
H08319
Author:
Date:
2209
RS–65
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS01N–16
INSPECTION
H08235
LH:
1.
VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION
Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
2.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION
(a) Do a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
(b) If the front fender of the car or its periphery is damaged,
do a visual check for damage to the front airbag sensor,
which includes the following items even if the airbag was
not deployed:
Bracket deformation
Paint peeling off the bracket
Cracks, dents or chips in the case
Cracks, dents, chipping and scratches in the connector
Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial number
RH:
H06728
Author:
Date:
2210
RS–66
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS01O–10
REPLACEMENT
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the front airbag sensor.
If the SRS has been deployed in a collision. (Replace both the left and right airbag sensors.)
If the front airbag sensor has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
If the front airbag sensor has been found to be faulty during checking items.
(See page RS–65)
If the front airbag sensor has been dropped.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the front airbag sensor, see page RS–64 and RS–67. Be sure to follow
the correct procedure.
Author:
Date:
2211
RS–67
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS01P–14
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
LH:
RH:
H06728
INSTALL FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH AND RH
Install the front airbag sensor with the arrow on the sensor
facing toward the front of the vehicle.
Torque: 20 N·m (205 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Connection of the connector is done after the sensor
assembly has been installed.
Make sure the sensor is installed with the specified
torque.
If the sensor has been dropped, or there are cracks,
dents or other defects in the case, brackets or connector, replace the removed sensor with a new one.
The front sensor is equipped with an electrical connection check mechanism. Be sure to lock this mechanism securely when connecting the connector. If the
connector is not securely locked, a malfunction code
will be detected by the diagnostic system.
(b) Connect the front airbag sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL HEAD LIGHT LH AND RH
(See page BE–28)
3.
INSTALL TURN SIGNAL LIGHT LH AND RH
Author:
Date:
2212
RS–68
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS01Q–06
COMPONENTS
Side Airbag Sensor Assembly
7.5 (76, 66 in.·lbf)
20 (205, 15)
Front Seat Outer Belt Retractor
42 (430, 31)
Center Pillar Lower Garnish
Front Door Scuff Plate
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
H03285
Author:
Date:
2213
RS–69
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS01R–05
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU and various
electrical devices unless absolutely necessary.
(If the IC terminals are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
1.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE
2.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT RETRACTOR
(See page BO–126)
Disconnect the pretensioner connector.
Remove the 2 bolts and retractor.
H01346
H01339
4.
REMOVE SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the side airbag sensor assembly connector.
NOTICE:
Disconnect the connector with the sensor assembly
installed.
(b) Using a torx wrench, remove the 3 screws and side airbag
sensor assembly.
Torx wrench: T40 (Part No.09042–00020 or locally
manufactured tool)
Author:
Date:
2214
RS–70
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS05V–03
INSPECTION
1.
VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION
Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
2.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS NOT DEPLOYED
Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
3.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG IS DEPLOYED
Replace the side airbag sensor assembly. (See page RS–69)
Author:
Date:
2215
RS–71
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS01T–06
REPLACEMENT
REPLACEMENT REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the side airbag sensor assembly.
If the side airbag sensor assembly has been deployed in a collision.
If the side airbag sensor assembly has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
If the side airbag sensor assembly has been dropped.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the side airbag sensor assembly, see page RS–69 and RS–72. Be sure
to follow the correct procedure.
Author:
Date:
2216
RS–72
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS05W–02
INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new ones.
Never reuse the side airbag sensor assembly involved in a collision when the airbag has deployed.
Never repair a sensor in order to reuse it.
1.
(a)
H01339
INSTALL SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Using a torx wrench, install the side airbag sensor assembly with the 3 screws.
Torx wrench: T40 (Part No.09042–00020 or locally
manufactured tool)
Torque: 20 N·m (205 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
(b) Connect the side airbag sensor assembly connector.
NOTICE:
Connection of the connector is done after the sensor
assembly has been installed. Make sure the sensor
assembly is installed with the specified torque.
If the sensor assembly has been dropped, or there are
cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or
connector, replace the sensor assembly with a new
one.
When installing the sensor assembly, take care that
the SRS wiring does not interfere with other parts and
is not pinched between other parts.
After installation, shake the sensor assembly to
check that there is no looseness.
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT RETRACTOR
(See page BO–134)
(a) Install the retractor with the 2 bolts.
Torque:
Upper bolt: 7.5 N·m (76 kgf·cm, 66 in.·lbf)
Lower bolt: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
(b)
3.
4.
Connect the pretensioner connector.
INSTALL CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE
H01352
Author:
Date:
2217
RS–73
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
RS01V–11
LOCATION
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Front Airbag Sensor (RH)
Combination Meter
(Warning Light)
Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
Spiral Cable
Side Airbag Assembly (RH)
Front Airbag
Sensor (LH)
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (RH)
Steering Wheel Pad
(with Airbag)
Side Airbag Sensor
Assembly (LH)
Seat Belt Pretensioner (LH)
Seat Belt Pretensioner (RH)
Side Airbag Assembly (LH)
H08282
Author:
Date:
2218
RS–74
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
RS01W–09
INSPECTION
HINT:
The SRS wire harness is integrated with the instrument panel wire harness assembly. All the connectors in
the system are a standard yellow color.
1.
VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION
Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
2.
VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION
(a) Do a diagnostic system check. (See page DI–626)
(b) Check breaks in all wires of the SRS wire harness, and exposed conductors.
(c) Check to see if the SRS wire harness connectors are cracked or chipped.
Author:
Date:
2219
RS–75
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
–
WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
RS01X–09
REPLACEMENT
In the following cases, replace the wire harness or connector.
If any part of the SRS wire harness or any connector has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
If any part of the SRS wire harness or any connector has been found to be faulty during checking
items. (See page RS–74)
CAUTION:
If the wire harness used in the SRS is damaged, replace the whole wire harness assembly.
Author:
Date:
2220
IG–1
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
IGNITION SYSTEM
IG0DB–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
”Cold” and ”Hot” in these sentences express the temperature of the coils themselves. ”Cold” is from
–10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and ”Hot” is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1.
INSPECT SPARK TEST
Check that the spark occurs.
(1) Disconnect the high–tension cord from the spark plug.
(2) Remove the spark plug.
(3) Install the spark plug to the high–tension cord.
(4) Ground the spark plug.
(5) See if spark occurs while engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
To prevent gasoline from being injected from injectors during this test, crank the engine for no more
than 5 – 10 seconds at time.
If the spark does not occur, do the test as follows:
SPARK TEST
NO
CHECK CONNECTION OF IGNITION COIL WITH
IGNITER CONNECTORS
Connect securely.
BAD
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF HIGH–TENSION CORDS
(See step 2)
Maximum resistance: 25 kΩ per cord
Replace cord(s).
BAD
OK
CHECK POWER SUPPLY TO IGNITION COILS WITH
IGNITERS
1. Turn ignition switch to ON.
2. Check that there is battery positive voltage at ignition
coil positive (+) terminal.
Check wiring between ignition switch to ignition
coils with igniters.
BAD
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF IGNITION COILS
(See step 4)
Resistance:
Cold
Hot
Secondary
9.7 – 16.7 kΩ 12.4 – 19.6 kΩ
Replace ignition coil(s) with igniter(s).
BAD
OK
Replace sensor(s).
CHECK RESISTANCE OF SENSORS
(See steps 5 and 6)
Resistance:
Cold
Hot
Camshaft position sensor 835 – 1,400 Ω 1,060 – 1,645 Ω
Crankshaft position sensor 985 – 1,600 Ω 1,265 – 1,890 Ω BAD
OK
CHECK IGT SIGNAL FROM ECM
(See page DI–22)
Check wiring between ECM and igniters, and
BAD then try another ECM.
TRY ANOTHER IGNITER
Author:
Date:
1683
IG–2
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
2.
(a)
INSPECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS
Remove the high–tension cords.
Disconnect the high–tension cords at the rubber boot. Do
not pull on the high–tension cords.
NOTICE:
Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor
inside.
CORRECT
WRONG
S05295
(b)
Ohmmeter
S05542
(b)
Megger
Ground
Using an ohmmeter, measure the high–tension cord resistance.
Maximum resistance: 25 kΩ per cord
If the resistance is greater than maximum, check the terminals.
If necessary, replace the high–tension cord.
(c) Reinstall the high–tension cords.
3.
INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
NOTICE:
Never use a wire brush for cleaning.
Never attempt to adjust the electrode gap on a used
spark plug.
Spark plugs should be replaced every 100,000 km
(60,000 miles).
(a) Disconnect the high–tension cords from the spark plugs.
IG0147
Inspect the electrode.
Using a megger (insulation resistance meter), measure
the insulation resistance.
Standard correct insulation resistance:
10 MΩ or more
If the resistance is less than specified, proceed to step (d).
HINT:
If a megger is not available, the following simple method of inspection provides fairly accurate results.
Simple Method:
Quickly race the engine to 4,000 rpm 5 times.
Remove the spark plug. (See step (c))
Visually check the spark plug.
If the electrode is dry ... OK
If the electrode is wet ... Proceed to step (d)
Reinstall the spark plug. (See step (g))
S03776
Author:
Date:
1684
IG–3
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
(c)
(d)
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 4 spark plugs.
Visually check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator damage.
If abnormal, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug:
16 mm Plug
Wrench
DENSO made
PK20TR11
NGK made
BKR6EKPB11
S05308
(e)
P20584
IG0152
Inspect the electrode gaps.
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug:
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
If the gap is greater than maximum, replace the spark plug.
Correct electrode gap for new spark plug:
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
NOTICE:
If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend only the base
of the ground electrode. Do not touch the tip. Never attempt
to adjust the gap on the used plug.
(f)
Clean the spark plugs.
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to dry and then
clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure: Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/cm2, 85 psi)
Duration: 20 seconds or less
HINT:
If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline before using the
spark plug cleaner.
(g) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the 4 spark plugs.
Torque: 18 N·m (180 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
(h) Reconnect the high–tension cords from the spark plugs.
4.
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
INSPECT IGNITION COILS WITH IGNITERS
Disconnect the high–tension cords from the ignition coils.
Inspect the secondary coil resistance.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the
high–tension terminals.
Secondary coil resistance:
Cold
9.7 – 16.7 kΩ
Hot
12.4 – 19.6 kΩ
B06373
Author:
Date:
1685
IG–4
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ignition coil.
(See page IG–6)
(c) Reconnect the high–tension cords to the ignition coils.
(d) Inspect the igniters. (See procedure spark test)
5.
(a)
(b)
Ohmmeter
S05528
Ohmmeter
S05310
INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold
835 – 1,400 Ω
Hot
1,060 – 1,645 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor. (See
page IG–9)
(c) Reconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
6.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold
985 – 1,600 Ω
Hot
1,265 – 1,890 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor. (See
page IG–12)
(c) Reconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Author:
Date:
1686
IG–5
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
IGNITION COIL
IGNITION COIL
IG041–03
COMPONENTS
Vacuum Hose
Accelerator Cable
Gasket
Throttle Cable
(A/T)
19 (195, 14)
Throttle Body
High–Tension Cord
Ignition Coil and No.2 Intake
Manifold Stay Assembly
EVAP Hose
Air Cleaner Hose
EVAP Hose
PCV Hose
EVAP Hose
Ignition Coil Connector
IAT Sensor
Connector
(TMMK Made)
(TMC Made)
Ignition Coil and No.2 Intake Manifold Stay Assembly
No.2 Intake
Manifold Stay
Air Cleaner Cap
VSV Connector
for EVAP
No.1 Ignition Coil
No.2 Ignition Coil
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B01286
Author:
Date:
1687
IG–6
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
IGNITION COIL
IG0DC–01
REPLACEMENT
1.
DISCONNECT THROTTLE BODY FROM INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page SF–32)
2.
Wire
Clamp
S05549
REMOVE IGNITION COILS AND NO.2 INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 ignition coil connectors.
(b) Disconnect the wire clamp from the manifold stay.
(c) TMC Made:
Remove the 2 nuts, 2 bolts, 2 ignition coils and manifold
stay assembly.
(d) TMMK Made:
Remove the nut, 3 bolts, 2 ignition coils and manifold stay
assembly.
3.
REMOVE IGNITION COILS FROM NO.2 INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY
Remove the 2 bolts and ignition coil. Remove the 2 ignition
coils.
4.
No.1
No.2
S05604
REINSTALL IGNITION COILS TO NO.2 INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY
Install the ignition coil with the 2 bolts. Install the 2 ignition coils.
Torque: 9.8 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 87 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
The installation positions of the ignition coils are different
for No.1 and No.2.
5.
REINSTALL IGNITION COILS AND NO.2 INTAKE MANIFOLD STAY ASSEMBLY
(a) TMC Made:
Install the 2 ignition coils and manifold stay assembly with
the 2 nuts and 2 bolts.
(b) TMMK Made:
Install the 2 ignition coils and manifold stay assembly with
the nut and 3 bolts.
Torque:
21 N·m (214 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf) for 12 mm head
42 N·m (428 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf) for 14 mm head
(c) Install the wire clamp to the manifold stay.
(d) Connect the 2 ignition coil connectors.
Author:
Date:
1688
IG–7
IGNITION (5S–FE)
6.
–
IGNITION COIL
REINSTALL THROTTLE BODY (See page SF–34)
Author:
Date:
1689
IG–8
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG044–03
COMPONENTS
Camshaft Position
Sensor Connector
Camshaft Position
Sensor
S03783
Author:
Date:
1690
IG–9
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG0DD–01
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the sensor connector.
Remove the bolt and sensor.
REINSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 9.5 N·m (97 kgf·cm, 84 in.·lbf)
Connect the sensor connector.
Author:
Date:
1691
IG–10
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG047–03
COMPONENTS
64 (650, 47)
64 (650, 47)
Engine Moving Control Rod
52 (530, 38)
Ground Strap Connector
No.2 RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Generator Drive Belt
PS Pump Drive Belt
RH Front Fender Apron Seal
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
S05284
Author:
Date:
1692
IG–11
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Generator Wire
Generator Connector
Generator
* Gasket
Wire
Clamp
No.2 Timing Belt
Cover
* Gasket
No.1 Timing Belt
Cover
Timing Belt Guide
Crankshaft
Pulley
108 (1,100, 80)
Wire Clamp
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Connector
Wire
Clamp
Wire Clamp
Crankshaft Position Sensor
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) :Specified torque
* Replace only if damaged
S05938
Author:
Date:
1693
IG–10
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG047–03
COMPONENTS
64 (650, 47)
64 (650, 47)
Engine Moving Control Rod
52 (530, 38)
Ground Strap Connector
No.2 RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Generator Drive Belt
PS Pump Drive Belt
RH Front Fender Apron Seal
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
S05284
Author:
Date:
1692
IG–11
IGNITION (5S–FE)
–
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Generator Wire
Generator Connector
Generator
* Gasket
Wire
Clamp
No.2 Timing Belt
Cover
* Gasket
No.1 Timing Belt
Cover
Timing Belt Guide
Crankshaft
Pulley
108 (1,100, 80)
Wire Clamp
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Connector
Wire
Clamp
Wire Clamp
Crankshaft Position Sensor
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) :Specified torque
* Replace only if damaged
S05938
Author:
Date:
1693
IG–1
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
IGNITION SYSTEM
IG0DF–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
”Cold” and ”Hot” in these sentences express the temperature of the coils themselves. ”Cold” is from –10°C (14°F) to
50°C (122°F) and ”Hot” is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C
(212°F).
1.
INSPECT IGNITER AND SPARK TEST
Check that the spark occurs.
(1) Remove the ignition coil.
(2) Remove the spark plug.
(3) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil, and connect
the ignition coil connector.
(4) Ground the spark plug.
(5) Check if spark occurs while engine is being
cranked.
NOTICE:
To prevent excess fuel being injected from the injectors
during this test, do not crank the engine for more 5 – 10 seconds at a time.
If the spark does not occur, do the test as follows:
SPARK TEST
NO
CHECK CONNECTION OF IGNITION COIL AND IGNITER
CONNECTORS
Connect securely.
BAD
OK
Replace the cord(s).
CHECK RESISTANCE OF HIGH–TENSION CORD
Maximum resistance: 25 kΩ per cord
BAD
OK
CHECK POWER SUPPLY OF HIGH–TENSION COIL AND IGNITER
1. Turn ignition switch to ON.
2. Check that there is battery voltage at ignition
coil positive (+) terminal.
BAD
Check wiring between ignition switch to
ignition coil and igniter.
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF IGNITION COIL
Resistance:
Cold
AISAN made:
Primary
0.70 – 0.94 Ω
Secondary
10.8 – 14.9 kΩ
Diamond made:
Primary
0.70 – 0.94 Ω
Secondary
6.8 – 11.7 kΩ
Replace the ignition coil (s).
Hot
0.85 – 1.10 Ω
13.1 – 17.5 kΩ
BAD
0.85 – 1.10 Ω
8.6 – 13.7 kΩ
OK
Continue to the next page
Author:
Date:
1695
IG–2
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
Continued from the previous page
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Resistance:
Cold
Hot
DENSO made:
1,060 – 1,645 Ω
835 – 1,400 Ω
2,145 – 3,010 Ω
1,690 – 2,560 Ω
Wabash made:
Replace the camshaft position sensor.
BAD
OK
CHECK RESISTANCE OF CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Resistance:
Cold
Hot
1,630 – 2,740 Ω
2,065 – 3,225 Ω
Replace the crankshaft position sensor.
BAD
OK
CHECK IGT SIGNAL FROM ECM
BAD
Check wiring between ECM and igniter, and
then try another ECM.
OK
TRY ANOTHER IGNITER
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS
Remove the V–bank cover.
Disconnect the high–tension cords from the spark plugs.
(1) Using needle–nose pliers, disconnect the cord
clamp from the engine wire protector.
B00848
(2)
WRONG
Disconnect the high–tension cords from the spark
plugs.
NOTICE:
Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor
inside.
(3) Disconnect the high–tension cords from the clamp.
CORRECT
P24453
(c)
P24457
Disconnect the high–tension cords from the ignition coils.
(1) Using a screwdriver, lift up the lock claw and disconnect the holder from the ignition coils.
(2) Disconnect the high–tension cord at the grommet.
NOTICE:
Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
Do not wipe any of the oil from the grommet after the
high–tension cord is disconnected.
Author:
Date:
1696
IG–3
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
(d)
(1)
(2)
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
Remove the high–tension cords set.
(1) Disconnect the clamp from the emission control
valve set.
(2) Remove the high–tension cords set in indicated
direction.
P25722
(e)
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
Maximum resistance: 25 kΩ per cord
If the resistance is greater than maximum, check the terminals.
If necessary, replace the high–tension cord.
Ohmmeter
P25768
(f)
Install the high–tension cords set.
S06107
Author:
Date:
1697
IG–4
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
(g)
Holder Grommet
CORRECT
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
Connect the high–tension cords to the ignition coils.
(1) Assemble the holder and grommet.
(2) Align the spline of the ignition coil with the spline of
the holder, and push in the cord.
P24458
WRONG
Clearance
S00813
(c)
Megger
Ground
NOTICE:
Check that the holder is correctly installed to the grommet
and ignition coil as shown in the illustration.
(3) Check that the lock claw of the holder is engaged by
lightly pulling the holder.
(h) Connect the high–tension cords to the spark plugs.
(i)
Install the V–bank cover.
3.
INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
NOTICE:
Never use a wire brush for cleaning.
Never attempt to adjust the electrode gap on a used
spark plug.
Spark plugs should be replaced every 100,000 km
(60,000 miles).
(a) Remove the high–tension cords set. (See step 2)
(b) Remove the ignition coils.
IG0147
Inspect the electrode.
Using a megger (insulation resistance meter), measure
the insulation resistance.
Standard correct insulation resistance:
10 MΩ or more
If the resistance is less than specified, proceed to step (e).
HINT:
If a megger is not available, the following simple method of inspection provides fairly accurate results.
(d)
Simple Method:
(1) Quickly race the engine to 4,000 rpm 5 times.
(2) Remove the spark plug. (See step (e))
(3) Visually check the spark plug.
If the electrode is dry ... OK
If the electrode is wet ... Proceed to step (f)
(4) Install the spark plug. (See step (i))
S03776
Author:
Date:
1698
IG–5
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
(e)
16 mm Plug
Wrench
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs
from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
P13225
(f)
Check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator
damage.
If abnormal, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug:
DENSO PK20TR11
DENSO made
PK20TR11
NGK made
BKR6EKPB11
NGK BKR6EKPB11
P25746
(g)
P20584
IG0152
Inspect the electrode gaps.
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug:
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
If the gap is greater than maximum, replace the spark plug.
Correct electrode gap for new spark plug:
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
NOTICE:
If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend only the base
of the ground electrode. Do not touch the tip. Never attempt
to adjust the gap on the used plug.
(h) Clean the spark plugs.
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to dry and then
clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure: Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/cm2, 85 psi)
Duration: 20 seconds or less
HINT:
If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline before using the
spark plug cleaner.
(i)
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the 6 spark plugs to
the RH and LH cylinder heads.
Torque: 18 N·m (180 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
(j)
Install the ignition coils.
(k) Install the high–tension cords set. (See step 2)
4.
INSPECT IGNITION COILS
(a) Disconnect the high–tension cords from the ignition coils.
(b) Disconnect the ignition coil connectors.
Author:
Date:
1699
IG–6
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
(c)
Ohmmeter
–
IGNITION SYSTEM
Using an ohmmeter, measure the primary coil resistance
between the positive (+) and negative (–) terminals.
Primary coil resistance:
Cold
0.70 – 0.94 Ω
Hot
0.85 – 1.10 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ignition coil.
S05622
Ohmmeter
(d)
Using an ohmmeter, measure the secondary coil resistance between the positive (+) and high–tension terminal.
Secondary coil resistance:
AISAN made
B00849
Ohmmeter
S04599
Cold
10.8 – 14.9 kΩ
AISAN made
Hot
13.1 – 17.5 kΩ
Diamond made
Cold
6.8 – 11.7 kΩ
Diamond made
Hot
8.6 – 13.7 kΩ
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ignition coil.
(e) Connect the ignition coil connectors.
(f)
Connect the high–tension cords to the ignition coils.
5.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
DENSO made
Cold
835 – 1,400 Ω
DENSO made
Hot
1,060 – 1,645 Ω
Wabash made
Cold
1,690 – 2,560 Ω
Wabash made
Hot
2,145 – 3,010 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
(c) Connect the camshaft position sensor connector.
Author:
Date:
1700
IG–7
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
IGNITION COIL
IGNITION COIL
IG02I–03
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT HIGH–TENSION CORDS FROM
IGNITION COILS (See page IG–1)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE IGNITION COILS
Disconnect the 3 connectors from the ignition coil.
Remove the 3 bolts and 3 ignition coils from the LH cylinder head.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
HINT:
Arrange the ignition coils in correct order.
S04720
Author:
Date:
1701
IG–8
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
IGNITION COIL
IG02J–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page IG–7)
Author:
Date:
1702
IG–9
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG02K–03
REMOVAL
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
S04589
Author:
Date:
1703
IG–10
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG02L–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page IG–9)
Author:
Date:
1704
IG–11
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG02M–03
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE RH FENDER APRON SEAL
2.
(a)
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Remove the bolt and disconnect the crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connecter.
(b)
P20105
Author:
Date:
1705
IG–12
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG02N–03
INSPECTION
Ohmmeter
P14244
NOTICE:
”Cold” and ”Hot” in these sentences express the temperature of the sensor itself. ”Cold” is from –10°C (14°F) to 50°C
(122°F) and ”Hot” is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold
1,630 – 2,740 Ω
Hot
2,065 – 3,225 Ω
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crankshaft position sensor.
Author:
Date:
1706
IG–13
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
–
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
IG02O–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page IG–11)
Author:
Date:
1707
Technical Service
BULLETIN
July 21, 2000
Introduction
A/C COMPRESSOR MAINTENANCE FOR
STORED VEHICLES
Models:
All Models
When a vehicle is stored for a long period (more than one month), the volume of oil
in the A/C compressor may decrease due to oil flow into the condenser, pipes, etc.
If the A/C system is turned on at high engine RPM after a long storage period, A/C
compressor damage may result.
To minimize the possibility of damage to the A/C compressor while storing a vehicle,
perform the following recommended maintenance procedure at least once a month to
lubricate the compressor.
Maintenance
Procedure
Recommended Maintenance Procedure For A/C Compressor Lubrication:
1. Turn off A/C and blower switches prior to starting engine.
2. Start and warm–up engine until engine speed drops below 1,000 RPM.
3. Turn on the A/C system (including the rear A/C) using the following settings:
S A/C switch: On
S Blower Speed: High
S Engine Speed: Below 1,000 RPM
4. Keep A/C on with engine idling for at least 30 seconds.
5. Turn off A/C system and stop engine.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
HEATING & AIR CONDITIONING
AC002–00
Title:
May 16, 1997
Introduction
All Models
The cassette tape head and capstan should be cleaned regularly to prevent poor sound
quality and/or cassettes from jamming.
Head
Pinch Roller
Capstan
Fig. 1
Conditions
The following conditions can easily be avoided by regularly cleaning the head with a tape
cleaner and only using good quality cassettes.
Poor Sound
Quality due to
Dirty Head
Since the tape head contacts the cassette tape, the tape head accumulates metal oxides
and dirt particles from the tape. In time, a layer of dirt forms on the tape head resulting in
poor transfer of information between the tape and the tape head. This typically causes a
reduction of the higher frequencies or a reduction of the brightness in sound quality.
Tape Speed
Tape speed is controlled by the tape capstan and pinch rollers. If the capstan and pinch
rollers accumulate dirt, the tape may slip causing the music to play too fast or too slow.
Jamming
Dirt can make the capstans sticky, causing the tape to become entangled in the cassette
mechanism. This can cause the cassette to become jammed in the player.
Cassette
Tape Head
Cleaners
To reduce the occurrence of these conditions, the following approved cassette cleaners are
available through the non–parts system (Material Distribution Center).
TOOLS & MATERIALS
MATERIAL NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
Allsop 3 Cassette Recorder Cleaner
00113–AS710–00
Cleaning Cassette and Cleaning
Solution with Instruction Sheet
NOTE:
Allow 15 minutes for the cleaning fluid to evaporate before playing a tape.
Page 1 of 2
AUDIO
Models:
AU001–97
TSB
CLEANING CASSETTE TAPE HEADS
AND CAPSTANS
REVISED
Title:
CLEANING CASSETTE TAPE HEADSAND CAPSTANS – AU001–97 (Revised)
Cassette
Tape Care
Procedure
May 16, 1997
The following precautions should be taken to keep cassettes in good condition:
1. Remove the cassette from the player when the cassette is not in use.
2. Store the cassette in its case.
3. Store the cassette in a cool, dry area away from direct sunlight and magnetic
components such as speakers.
4. Avoid touching the tape itself. This could result in poor sound quality or sound drop out.
5. Keep the tape tightly wound as shown in
figure 2. Tape speed can be affected by
loosely wound tape.
Use a pencil
to tighten up
loose tapes.
Fig. 2
Peeling Label
6. Avoid inserting a cassette into the player if
the cassette label is loose or peeling as
shown in figure 3. This can cause a
cassette to become stuck in the player.
Fig. 3
7. Use cassettes that are 90 minutes or
less in length. Cassettes over 90
minutes use extremely thin tape that is
subject to stretch, resulting in poor
sound quality.
Page 2 of 2
Tape length
in minutes
Fig. 4
AUDIO
AU002–96
OCTOBER 25, 1996
ALL MODELS
AM STATIC NOISE ON VEHICLES WITH POWER ANTENNAS
Page 1 of 2
Vehicles with power antennas may exhibit audible electrical noise on weak AM stations when
various electrical accessories (turn signals, rear defogger, cruise control, brakes, etc.) are operated.
Poor antenna grounding can cause this condition.
To eliminate or reduce the intensity of the noise, use the following repair procedure:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Tune the radio to a strong, static–free AM
station and slowly move the tip of the
antenna mast forward and back
approximately 2 inches (Fig. 1). If static
noise is not heard, go to Step 2. If static
noise is heard during antenna movement,
replace the antenna mast and go to Step 3.
Fig. 1
NOTE:
Do not touch the antenna mast with
your bare hands. Use a glove or
nonmetallic object to move the
antenna. (If you touch the antenna
with your hands, you will change the
antenna sensitivity).
Inspection
Area
Fig. 2
2. Remove the antenna mast and inspect the
base of the mast for corrosion and damage
(Fig. 2). Clean with 1500 grit sandpaper.
3. Remove the antenna assembly and inspect
the inner fender around the antenna hole
for corrosion (Fig. 3). Clean with 1500 grit
sandpaper.
Fig. 3
AM STATIC NOISE ON VEHICLES WITH POWER ANTENNAS
Page 2 of 2
REPAIR PROCEDURE (Cont’d):
4. Remove the antenna spacer grommet at the
top of the antenna assembly and inspect for
corrosion (Fig. 4). Clean with 1500 grit
sandpaper.
Inspection
Area
Fig. 4
5. Reinstall the antenna assembly. Be sure to
install the external antenna nut (escutcheon)
first. Then install the nut which holds the
assembly to the inner bracket (Fig. 5).
2
1
3
Push
6. Check to make sure that the teeth on the
antenna spacer grommet make good contact
with the inner fender well (Fig. 6).
Fig. 5
Antenna
Teeth
Fender
Fig. 6
7. Inspect the antenna cable connection and
clean as necessary (Fig. 7). Reconnect the
antenna cable, the wire harness and the drain
hose.
Inspection
Area
Fig. 7
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
OPCODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
AU6001
Listed repair procedure
(All items)
1.0
86300–XXXXX
76
73
Technical Service
BULLETIN
TOYOTA DINGHY" TOWING GUIDE
Models:
All Models
March 17, 2000
Introduction
The chart on the next page indicates which Toyota vehicles can be Dinghy towed (towed
with four wheels on the ground) behind a Motorhome.
CAUTION:
Dinghy towing a vehicle behind a Motorhome requires special towing equipment
and accessories. Please see your Motorhome Manufacturer / Service Outlet for
recommended towing equipment.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ACCESSORIES
AX001–00
Title:
TOYOTA “DINGHY” TOWING GUIDE – AX001–00
Affected
Vehicles
March 17, 2000
S All Models
DINGHY TOWABLE
SPEED/DISTANCE
LIMITS
YEAR
MODEL
1995 – 2000
Avalon
1992 – 2000
Camry
Yes
No
None
1999 – 2000
Solara
Yes
No
None
1994 – 1999
Celica
Yes
No
None
2000
Celica GT
Yes
No
None
2000
Celica GT–S
Yes
–
None
–
Yes
55 MPH / 200 Miles
1993 – 2000
Corolla
Yes
No
None
2000
ECHO
Yes
No
None
1992 – 2000
Land Cruiser
2000
MR2 Spyder
Yes
N/A
None
1996 – 1998
Paseo
Yes
No
None
1992 – 1997
Previa 2WD
Not Towable
–
1992 – 1997
Previa 4WD
Not Towable
–
1998 – 2000
Sienna
Not Towable
–
1994 – 1999
Supra
Not Towable
–
1996 – 2000
RAV4 2WD
Yes
No
None
1996 – 2000
RAV4 4WD
Yes
No
None
1995 – 1998
Tercel
Yes
No
None
1996 – 2000
4Runner 2WD
Not Towable
–
1996 – 2000
4Runner 4WD
Not Towable
–
1995 – 2000
Tacoma 2WD
Not Towable
–
1995 – 2000
Tacoma 4WD
Not Towable
–
1993 – 1999
T100 2WD
Not Towable
–
1993 – 1999
T100 4WD
Not Towable
–
2000
Tundra 2WD
Not Towable
–
2000
Tundra 4WD
Not Towable
–
M/T
A/T
Not Towable
Not Towable
–
–
NOTE:
After “Dinghy” Towing, or at the recommended distance limits, let the Engine idle for
more than 3 minutes before operating the vehicle or resuming towing.
NOTE:
Vehicles that are Dinghy towable will not sustain internal damage to the transmission
or transfer components, as long as speed/distance limits are observed. The
transmission must be placed in the “neutral” position when Dinghy towing. Dinghy
towing these vehicles does not eliminate the possibility of damage to other vehicle
systems (Body, Chassis, Electrical Systems, etc.).
Page 2 of 2
RETRO-FIT INTERNAL TRUNK
RELEASE KITS
Models:
All Applicable ’90 – ’00 Models
March 9, 2001
Introduction
In order to respond to requests of our valued customers, we are offering Retro–Fit
Internal Trunk Release Kits. These kits allow the trunk to be opened from the inside in
case of entrapment.
Applicable
Vehicles
MODEL
MODEL CODE
MODEL YEAR
# CLAMPS
MCX10
1995 – 1999
4
MCX20
2000
4
SXV10, MCV10, VCV10
1992 – 1996
4
SXV20, MCV20
1997 – 2000
4
AT200, ST204
1994 – 1999
4
AE10#
1993 – 1997
4
ZZE110
1998 – 2000
5
ECHO
NCP12
2000
4
MR2
SW20, 21
1990 – 1995
2
EL44
1992 – 1995
4
EL54
1996 – 1999
4
SXV20, MCV20
1999 – 2000
4
EL42
1991 – 1994
4
EL53
1995 – 1999
4
Avalon
Camry
Celica (Coupe)
Corolla (Sedan)
Paseo
Solara
Tercel
Parts
Information
Installation
Procedure
Warranty
Information
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
–
64640–33030
Trunk Release
–
64610–17040
Trunk Release (MR2 Only)
–
90464–00551
Clamp
–
MDC 00107–00316–TR
Installation Instructions
Order the appropriate trunk release, at least as many clamps as listed above, and a set
of installation instructions. Follow the installation procedure detailed in the installation
instructions. Installation time is 0.7 hours.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
ACCESSORIES
Technical Service
BULLETIN
AX001-01
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 31, 2000
Introduction
PORT INSTALLED RS3000 TVIP TRUNK
COURTESY CONNECTION
Models:
’99 Camry
The trunk courtesy connection for 1999 model year Camry vehicles equipped with a Port
Installed Option RS3000 (V3) has been relocated from the luggage compartment light
switch to below the dash (lower finish panel) on the driver’s side in the Instrument Panel
J/B. (Refer to Illustrations A & B on page 2.)
S The location was changed to improve the installation process.
S A splicing connector is used for the new trunk courtesy wire installation (blue) to the
vehicle’s wire harness at Instrument Panel J/B (red/yellow).
S The previous location is the same as the dealer installed RS3000 trunk courtesy
connection to the luggage compartment light switch connection.
For service related purposes, this bulletin describes the procedures to locate the new
trunk courtesy connection at Instrument Panel J/B in vehicles equipped with PIO
RS3000.
LED
Microphone
Remote Control
S
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
The remote transmitter has two
buttons, Top and Bottom.
Status Monitor
S
The status monitor has a Toyota label,
LED, and microphone.
S 1999 model year Camry vehicles equipped with PIO (V3) TVIP.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ACCESSORIES
AX003–00
Title:
PORT INSTALLED RS3000 TVIP TRUNK COURTESY CONNECTION – AX003–00
Locating
Procedure
March 31, 2000
New Location:
These steps below are to be followed to
locate the new trunk courtesy connection
when servicing Camry vehicles equipped
with the PIO RS3000 TVIP.
1. Remove the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the driver’s step cover.
3. Remove the driver’s cowl cover (1
nut).
4. Locate the Connector Junction Block
in the driver’s cowl area. You will
notice a RED/YELLOW wire routed to
the Blue 10P connector which
terminates at an adjacent splicing
connector. This is the TVIP Trunk
Courtesy Wire.
Connector
Junction Block
10P
Connector
(Blue)
Illustration A
5. Disconnect the Blue 10P connector
from the Connector Junction Block.
With the tab of the Blue 10P
connector facing up, look at the back
(wire side) and locate the wire in the
bottom row, second space from the
right, which has the splicing connector
attached to it. This is the Vehicle’s
Trunk Courtesy Signal Wire.
6. After completing the parts inspection
and repairs if applicable, reconnect
the Blue 10P connector and install all
previously removed parts.
Wire Side View
TVIP Trunk
Courtesy Wire
(Yellow/Red)
Splicing
Connector
10P
Connector
(Blue)
Previous Location:
The White 1P connector for the Vehicle’s
Trunk Courtesy Signal is located at the
trunk courtesy lamp switch near the trunk
latch in the vehicle’s trunk.
Page 2 of 2
Illustration B
Technical Service
BULLETIN
TOYOTA DINGHY" TOWING GUIDE
Models:
All Models
March 19, 1999
Introduction
The following chart indicates which Toyota vehicles can be Dinghy towed (towed with four
wheels on the ground) behind a Motorhome.
CAUTION:
Dinghy towing a vehicle behind a Motorhome requires special towing equipment and
accessories. Please see your Motorhome Manufacturer / Service Outlet for
recommended towing equipment.
Affected
Vehicles
S All Models
DINGHY TOWABLE
YEAR
MODEL
M/T
1995–1999
1992–1999
1993–1999
1995–1998
1996–1998
1994–1999
1994–1998
1996–1999
1996–1999
1995–1999
1995–1999
1996–1999
1996–1999
1993–1998
1993–1998
1992–1999
1992–1999
1992–1999
1998–1999
Avalon
Camry
Corolla
Tercel
Paseo
Celica
Supra
RAV4 2WD
RAV4 4WD
Tacoma 2WD
Tacoma 4WD
4Runner 2WD
4Runner 4WD
T100 2WD
T100 4WD
Land Cruiser
Previa 2WD
Previa 4WD
Sienna
A/T
SPEED/DISTANCE
LIMITS
Not Towable
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Not Towable
Yes
No
Yes
No
Not Towable
Not Towable
Not Towable
Not Towable
Not Towable
Not Towable
Not Towable
Not Towable
Not Towable
Not Towable
–
None
None
None
None
None
–
None
None
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
NOTE:
Vehicles that are Dinghy towable will not sustain internal damage to the transmission
or transfer components. The transmission must be placed in the “neutral” position
when Dinghy towing. Dinghy towing these vehicles does not eliminate the possibility
of damage to other vehicle systems (Body, Chassis, Electrical Systems, etc.)
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
ACCESSORIES
AX004–99
Title:
Models:
‘97 Camry
April 25, 1997
Introduction
Affected
Vehicles
Procedure
ACCESSORY
TSB
1997 CAMRY REAR SPOILER INSTALLATION
AX005-97
Title:
Upon installation of the rear spoiler, as outlined in the Dealer Installation Instruction sheet
enclosed with the spoiler, please follow the outlined procedure for verification of the trunk
lid operation:
1997 Model Year Camry.
1. Reinstall the carpet trim panel on the
inside of the trunk lid with the
appropriate fasteners.
Upper Slot
2. The trunk lid must remain open and
hold its position, up to approximately
45 degrees from horizontal as shown.
3. If the trunk lid does not hold its open
position and the trunk lid closes:
a. Move the end of one of the torsion
rods to the next upper open slot.
b. Verify that the trunk lid functions
as outlined above.
c. If the condition is not corrected,
adjust the other torsion bar to
the next upper open slot position.
4. If the trunk lid does not hold its open
position and the trunk lid opens fully
forcibly:
Lower Slot
a. Move the end of one of the torsion
rods to the next lower open slot
position.
b. Verify that the trunk lid functions
as outlined above.
c. If the condition is not corrected,
please adjust the other torsion
bar to the next lower open slot
position.
NOTE:
Upon completion of the procedure
described in this bulletin, please refer
to the Dealer Installation Instructions
for final checks.
Page 1 of 1
Technical Service
BULLETIN
TOYOTA VIP RS3000 PROGRAMMING
Models:
All Models
April 9, 1999
Introduction
This bulletin describes the procedures that are used to program the two–button remote
control for vehicles that are equipped with the dealer or port installed option (PIO), not
the factory security system. For factory security system remote control programming,
refer to the appropriate vehicle repair manual.
Verification of the dealer or PIO Toyota VIP can easily be performed by identifying the
status monitor or remote transmitter.
LED
Microphone
Remote Control
S The remote transmitter has two
buttons, Top and Bottom.
Status Monitor
S The status monitor has a Toyota
label, LED, and microphone.
Starting with 1998 MY, the remote controls for the RS3000 System were revised with new
coding logics. The color of the remote control cases was changed from Black to Gray to
help identify the new remote controls. The new (Gray) remote controls will not work with
the RS3000 ECU’s produced prior to 1998 MY. The old (Black) remote controls are still
available for Service Parts.
NOTE:
The TVIP is programmed to operate with the two remote controls that come with the
vehicle. The ECU (computer) can be programmed to operate with up to four different
remote controls. For customer satisfaction, request that any existing remote be
furnished when programming a new or replacement unit.
Affected
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S All models with dealer or PIO equipped Toyota VIP (RS3000)
CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not applicable to warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
ACCESSORIES
AX005–99
Title:
TOYOTA VIP RS3000 PROGRAMMING – ALL MODELS – AX005–99
Programming
Procedure
April 9, 1999
For location of the RS3000 ECU, refer to ECU Mounting Locations, Page 4.
I.
To program (add) a REMOTE CONTROL to the system:
1. Insert the key into ignition switch,
and turn it to “ON”.
2. Press and hold the ECU’s
PROGRAMMING SWITCH for 3
seconds.
Press and Hold
for 3 Seconds
The STATUS MONITOR LED
turns on for 5 seconds.
NOTE:
YOU MUST PERFORM THE NEXT
STEP WITHIN 5 SECONDS.
3. Press and release a REMOTE
CONTROL’s top or bottom
button.*
Lights Up
Press Once
The STATUS MONITOR LED
turns off.
The Piezo “chirper” chirps once.
The exterior lights flash once.
4. Turn off the ignition. The ECU will
now operate with the REMOTE
CONTROL just programmed.
*
Page 2 of 4
Either button on your REMOTE CONTROL can be programmed to operate the system. The bottom
button can be programmed to operate a second vehicle with the Toyota VIP.
TOYOTA VIP RS3000 PROGRAMMING – ALL MODELS – AX005–99
Programming
Procedure
(Continued)
April 9, 1999
II. To erase all REMOTE CONTROL codes from the system:
1. Insert key into the ignition switch,
and turn it to “ON”.
2. Press and hold the ECU’s
PROGRAMMING SWITCH for 3
seconds.
Press and Hold
for 3 Seconds
The STATUS MONITOR LED
turns on for 5 seconds.
NOTE:
YOU MUST PERFORM THE NEXT
STEP WITHIN 5 SECONDS.
Lights Up
3. Press and hold the ECU’s
PROGRAMMING SWITCH for
over 2 seconds again.
The STATUS MONITOR LED
turns off, then flashes 3 times.
The Piezo “chirper” chirps three
times and the exterior lights flash
3 times.
Press and Hold Again, for 2
Seconds
4. Turn off the ignition. The ECU has cleared all REMOTE CONTROL codes; until
another REMOTE CONTROL is programmed, the system will not work with any
REMOTE CONTROL.
Page 3 of 4
TOYOTA VIP RS3000 PROGRAMMING – ALL MODELS – AX005–99
ECU MOUNTING LOCATIONS
1. ’98 Model and prior has ECU located beneath the driver’s seat.
2. ’97 Model and prior has ECU located beneath the driver’s seat.
Page 4 of 4
April 9, 1999
Technical Service
BULLETIN
April 14, 2000
Introduction
RS3000 TVIP AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK
FEATURE PROGRAMMING
Models:
All Models
As a convenience feature, the RS3000 TVIP system is programmed to automatically lock
all of the vehicle’s doors (for vehicles equipped with power door locks) when the ignition
key is turned to “ON” or “START”, and unlock them when the key is turned back to “ACC”
or “LOCK”. The initial factory setting of this programmable feature is “ON”. For some
customers however, this feature is not desirable due to instances of passenger lockout
when the driver enters the vehicle first and starts the ignition.
For vehicles equipped with RS3000 TVIP, this bulletin advises the dealers to
communicate the following information to the customers at vehicle delivery:
1. Inform the customers of the RS3000 system’s automatic (ignition controlled) door
lock/unlock feature.
2. Inquire about the customers’ preference for it to be set “ON” or “OFF”.
3. Reprogram the feature’s setting according to the customer’s preference.
To change the feature’s operation mode, follow the programming procedures on page 2.
Verification of the Dealer–Installed Option (DIO) or Port–Installed Option (PIO) RS3000
TVIP System can easily be performed by identifying the status monitor and remote
transmitter.
LED
Microphone
Remote Control
S
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
The remote transmitter has two
buttons, Top and Bottom.
Status Monitor
S
The status monitor has a Toyota label,
LED, and microphone.
S All models equipped with DIO or PIO RS3000 TVIP.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ACCESSORIES
AX005–00
Title:
RS30000 TVIP AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCK FEATURE PROGRAMMING – AX005–00
Programming
Procedure
April 14, 2000
AUTOMATIC (IGNITION–CONTROLLED) DOOR LOCKING/UNLOCKING FUNCTION
The factory setting for the Automatic Door Locking/Unlocking Function is “ON”.
To change this feature’s operation, follow the steps below:
1. Sit in the driver’s seat with driver’s door open.
2. Insert the key into the ignition switch, and turn it to “ON” position (not “ACC”)
5 times (ON > LOCK > ON > LOCK > ON > LOCK > ON > LOCK > ON) within a
10 second period.
System Response: The STATUS MONITOR’s LED turns on, and the PIEZO
BUZZER sounds once.
NOTE:
You must perform the next steps within 30 seconds.
3. Select the customer’s preferred operating mode.
Mode
Programming Step
Programming Completion
Turn the ignition switch to the
“LOCK” position.
AUTOMATIC DOOR
LOCKING/UNLOCKING “ON”
AUTOMATIC DOOR
LOCKING/UNLOCKING “OFF”
Page 2 of 2
Close the driver’s door.
Close the driver’s door,
then open and close it
one more time.
System Response:
The PIEZO BUZZER sounds
once, and the exterior lights
flash once.
Turn the ignition switch to the
“LOCK” position.
System Response:
The PIEZO BUZZER sounds
twice, and the exterior lights
flash twice.
Technical Service
BULLETIN
April 23, 1999
Introduction
RS3000 TVIP PROGRAMMING CHANGES
FOR GBS
Models:
All Models
Starting with 1999 MY, the programming in the RS3000 ECU for the Glass Breakage
Sensor (GBS) to trigger the alarm has been changed to improve the Toyota Vehicle
Intrusion Protection (TVIP) system’s theft warning feature when glass breakage or impact
to the glass is detected.
Previous operation of GBS (for 1998 MY and prior):
S Upon (first) detection of breakage of the vehicle’s glass, the GBS will sound the
security system for 5 seconds (3 horn honks).
S If there is a second detection of glass breakage, within 5 seconds of the first
detection, the security system will sound for the full duration of 59 seconds.
Improved operation of GBS (from 1999 MY):
S Upon (first) detection of breakage of the vehicle’s glass, the GBS will sound the
security system for 20 seconds.
S If there is a second detection of glass breakage, the security system will sound for the
full duration of 59 seconds, regardless of time between the first and second
detections.
S After the first detection, any subsequent detection will trigger the alarm for the full
duration of 59 seconds as long as the security system is armed. The GBS trigger
cycle will reset once the security system is disarmed and then rearmed.
This improvement is intended to enhance the previous trigger cycle of the security
system and ward off an intruder.
The color of the previous (1998 MY and prior) RS3000 ECU was black. The new
RS3000 ECU color is gray.
Affected
Vehicles
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
S All Models
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
08585–00921
SAME
RS3000 Base Kit
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not applicable to warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ACCESSORIES
AX006–99
Title:
RS3000 TVIP PROGRAMMING CHANGES FOR GBS – AX006–99
Repair
Procedure
April 23, 1999
When performing the RS3000 System Test, check the Glass Breakage Sensor sensitivity
as follows:
1. Press and release the Remote Control’s top button to arm the system.
2. Wait two seconds.
3. With the tip of the ignition key (or striker tool), softly tap the center of the driver’s door
window glass.
S If the system is triggered (horn sounds for 20 seconds), the sensitivity must be
adjusted. Turn the Glass Breakage Sensor ECU’s adjustment screw clockwise
one notch, and repeat this step again.
4. If the system is not triggered, repeat the glass tapping with moderate force.
S The system should trigger when the glass is tapped with moderate force. If it is
not triggered, turn the Glass Breakage Sensor ECU’s adjustment screw clockwise
one notch, and repeat this step again.
CAUTION:
Use caution when performing the step above. Do not tap the window glass with too
much force, or the glass may crack or break. Use extra caution when the temperature
is extremely cold.
NOTE:
The Owner’s Guide included in the RS3000 Base Kit is changed to reflect the
(GBS logic) improvement. There is no change to the GBS ECU itself.
Page 2 of 2
INTERCHANGEABILITY OF ACCESSORY
ALLOY WHEELS
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’99 – ’01 Avalon, Camry, Solara & Sienna
September 22, 2000
Introduction
This bulletin introduces a new accessory alloy wheel for 1999 through 2001 model year
Avalon, Camry, Solara and Sienna vehicles. This new wheel is similar in appearance to
an existing alloy wheel. This bulletin points out that the two wheels are not
interchangeable.
Applicable
Vehicles
S 1999 – 2001 model year Avalon, Camry, Solara & Sienna.
Parts
Information
WHEEL
WHEEL PART NUMBER
REMARK
Style 1, Split 5 Spoke
PT351–00990
Conical (Tapered) Seat Lug Nut
Style 2, Split 5 Spoke
PT351–00991
Flat Seat Lug Nut
Flat Seat Lug Nut
Conical (Tapered)
Seat Lug Nut
Every applicable vehicle must be installed with all four wheels of the same part number.
In cases where replacement of one wheel is necessitated, it must be replaced by a wheel
of the same part number. Replacement of one part number with the other is permitted
only as a set of four wheels.
The service part numbers for the lug nuts are not interchangeable.
WHEEL PART NUMBER
LUG NUT PART NUMBER
LUG NUT DESCRIPTION
PT351–00990
PT351–00990–LN
Conical (Tapered) Seat
PT351–00991
PT351–12009–01
Flat Seat
The service part numbers for the center caps are not interchangeable.
Warranty
Information
WHEEL PART NUMBER
CENTER CAP PART NUMBER
PT351–00990
PT351–00991–WC
PT351–00991
PT351–00991–CC
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
ACCESSORIES
AX007–00
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SEAT BELT EXTENDER
Models:
’98 – ’00 Model Year
January 21, 2000
Introduction
Toyota customers who find it necessary to
increase the length of their seat belts may
obtain Seat Belt Extenders at no cost
through their local Toyota dealer.
Seat Belt
S The extender is available in 6 inch, 9 inch,
12 inch, 15 inch and 18 inch lengths.
S The extender is available only in black.
Extender
S Owners are informed of the seat belt
extender availability through the Toyota
Owner’s Manual included in each vehicle.
The customer (individual requiring the extender) must visit a Toyota dealership to have
the required measurements made and to complete the seat belt extender worksheet.
The worksheet will allow the proper fitting and selection of a seat belt extender for the
customer. The dealership personnel should then determine the applicable part number
and place a Critical Order through the TDN Parts Network.
The dealership service department should complete the affixed Seat Belt Extender Label
and review the “owner instruction sheet” with the customer. The dealership should give a
copy of the completed worksheet to the customer and keep the original in the customer’s
file.
To assure utmost owner satisfaction, it is recommended that a dealership designate one
person to coordinate all activities related to the seat belt extender issue.
From past sales history, it is recommended that dealerships do not stock Seat belt
extenders due to low demand and the need for customer fitting.
This bulletin contains the following information:
Procedure and Sample Label.................Page 2
Application Charts .................................Page 3–4
Part Number Information........................Page 5
Owner Instructions..................................Page 6
Seat Belt Extender Worksheet............... Page 7
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S All Toyota models, 1998 through 2000 model years.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 7
BODY
BO002–00
Title:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’98 – ’00 – BO002–00
Procedure
January 21, 2000
1. Owner requests a seat belt extender from dealer.
2. Dealer verifies the need for a seat belt extender and obtains a current copy of this
TSB and copies the worksheet.
3. Dealer measures the customer and completes the worksheet. Dealer determines the
correct part number and places a Critical Order for the part through the TDN Parts
Network.
4. Dealer receives seat belt extender and calls the customer in to check fit of the part.
5. If the seat belt extender fit is good, dealership personnel completes the customer
information label on the part, explains usage of the part, and gives the customer a
copy of the completed worksheet.
6. Dealer places a copy of the completed worksheet in the customer’s records.
PARTS
SUPPLY
DEALER
MEASURE
CUSTOMER
&
COMPLETE
WORKSHEET
PLACE
CRITICAL
ORDER
THROUGH
TDN
SHIP SEAT
BELT
EXTENDER
TO
DEALER
DEALER
TEST FIT
CUSTOMER
WITH PART
COMPLETE
LABEL AND
ADVISE
OWNER
FILE
WORKSHEET
IN
CUSTOMER
RECORDS
Sample Seat
Belt Extender
Customer
Information
Label
Page 2 of 7
CAUTION
OWNER
RECEIVE
COPY OF
WORKSHEET
& USE
EXTENDER
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’98 – ’00 – BO002–00
Front Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
January 21, 2000
FRONT SEAT – EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
’00
’99
’98
RAV4
—
R–5
R–5
R–5
RAV4 EV
—
R–5
R–5
R–5
—
R–5
R–5
—
R–5
R–5
CONVERTIBLE
—
N–6
N–6
—
K–5
—
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
—
N–6
—
—
LIFTBACK & COUPE
N–6
CONVERTIBLE
—
N–6
N–6
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
TERCEL
RH
LH
COUPE (RH)
COUPE (LH)
PASEO
ECHO
COROLLA
MR2
CELICA
TMMC PRODUCTION
NUMMI PRODUCTION
TMC PRODUCTION
CAMRY
TMMK PRODUCTION
CAMRY
SOLARA
COUPE
Q–4
Q–4
—
COVERTIBLE
Q–4
—
—
SUPRA
—
—
—
R–3
—
T–1
Q–2
Q–2
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
—
S–1
S–1
S–1
4RUNNER
—
K–5
K–5
K–5
LAND CRUISER
—
K–5
K–5
K–5
T100 *1
—
—
—
R–5
TUNDRA *1
—
Q–4
—
—
AVALON
*1
SIENNA
TACOMA
*1
*1 The extender must not be used for the center seat belt of Avalon, Tacoma, T100 and Tundra which have
bench seats.
Page 3 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’98 – ’00 – BO002–00
Rear Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
January 21, 2000
REAR SEAT – EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
RAV4
RAV4 EV
TERCEL
PASEO
ECHO
COROLLA
CELICA
CAMRY
TYPE
W/TOKAI RIKA
’01
R–5*1
’00
R–5*1
’99
R–5*1
W/QSS
Q–4*2
Q–4*2
Q–4*2
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
W/TOKAI RIKA
—
R–5*1
R–5*1
W/QSS
—
Q–4*2
Q–4*2
COUPE
—
R–5
R–5
CONVERTIBLE (RH)
—
N–3
N–1*3,
N–3*4
CONVERTIBLE (LH)
—
N–6
N–5*3,
N–6*4
—
R–5
—
—
TMMC PRODUCTION
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
NUMMI PRODUCTION
T–1
T–1
T–1
LIFTBACK & COUPE
N–6
N–6
N–6
CONVERTIBLE (RH)
—
N–1
N–1
CONVERTIBLE (LH)
—
N–5
N–5
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
TMC PRODUCTION
TMMK PRODUCTION
CAMRY
SOLARA
COUPE
Q–4
Q–4
—
CONVERTIBLE
Q–4
—
—
SUPRA
—
—
—
R–3
AVALON
—
T–1
Q–2
Q–2
SIENNA
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
TACOMA
XTRACAB
A–2
A–2
A–2
4RUNNER
—
R–5
R–5
R–5
LAND CRUISER
—
K–5
K–5
K–5
T100
XTRACAB
—
—
K–4
TUNDRA
ACCESS CAB
Q–4
—
—
*1 This seat belt was supplied by TOKAI RIKA.
Make sure that the I/D mark on the back side of
the seat belt buckle is the same as shown.
*2 This seat belt was supplied by QSS. Make sure
that the I/D mark on the back side of the seat belt
buckle is the same as shown.
*3 N–1 and N–5 are applied to PASEO convertible from September 1997 to November 1997 production.
*4 N–3 and N–6 are applied to PASEO convertible from December 1997 production.
Page 4 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’98 – ’00 – BO002–00
Parts
Information
January 21, 2000
PART NUMBER PREFIX: 73399–
SERIES
LENGTH
6 INCH
9 INCH
12 INCH
15 INCH
18 INCH
R–1
–12010
–12020
–12030
–12040
–12050
R–2
–12160
–12170
–12180
–12190
–12200
R–3
–50010
–50020
–50030
–50040
–50050
R–4
–16010
–16020
–16030
–16040
–16050
R–5
–16060
–16070
–16080
–16090
–16100
N–1
–12060
–12070
–12080
–12090
–12100
N–3
–20011
–20021
–20031
–20041
–20051
N–4
–20060
–20070
–20080
–20090
–20100
N–5
–20110
–20120
–20130
–20140
–20150
N–6
–20160
–20170
–20180
–20190
–20200
K–1
–12110
–12120
–12130
–12140
–12150
K–2
–22010
–22020
–22030
–22040
–22050
K–3
–22060
–22070
–22080
–22090
–22100
K–4
–33010
–33020
–33030
–33040
–33050
K–5
–35010
–35020
–35030
–35040
–35050
A–1
–02010
–02020
–02030
–02040
–020050
A–2
–01060*1
–01070
–01080
–01090
–01100
Q–1
–02060
–02070
–02080
–02090
–02100
Q–2
–06010
–06020
–06030
–06040
–06050
Q–3
–06060
–06070
–06080
–06090
–06100
Q–4
–0W010
–0W020
–0W030
–0W040
–0W050
S–1
–04010
–04020
–04030
–04040
–04050
T–1
–01110
–01120
–01130
–01140
–01150
*1 Length: 7 1/4”
Page 5 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’98 – ’00 – BO002–00
Owner
Instructions
January 21, 2000
Failure to follow the recommendations indicated below could result in less effectiveness
of the seat belt restraint system in case of vehicle collision, causing personal injury.
The Seat Belt Extender must not be used:
A. By anyone other than for whom it was provided (name recorded on seat belt
extender).
B. In any vehicle and/or seat position other than the one for which it was provided.
C. When the Seat Belt Extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic
locking retractor), make sure the retractor is locked when in use.
If your seat belt cannot be fastened securely because it is not long enough, a
personalized seat belt extender is available from your Toyota dealer free of charge.
Please contact your local Toyota dealer so that the dealer can order the proper required
length for the extender. Bring the heaviest coat you expect to wear for proper
measurement and selection of length. Additional ordering information is available at your
Toyota dealer.
CAUTION:
When using the seat belt extender, observe the following. Failure to follow these
instructions could result in less effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in case
of vehicle accident, increasing the chance of personal injury.
S Never use the Seat Belt Extender if you can COMFORTABLY fasten the seat belt
without it.
S The Seat Belt Extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
S Remember that the extender provided for you may not be safe when used on a
different vehicle, or for another person or at a different seating position than the
one originally intended for.
To connect the extender to the seat
belt, insert the tab into the seat belt
buckle so that the “PRESS” signs on
the buckle–release buttons of the
extender and the seat belt are both
facing outward as shown.
Seat Belt Release
You will hear a click when the tab locks
into the buckle.
When releasing the seat belt, press on
the buckle–release button on the
extender, not on the seat belt. This helps
prevent damage to the vehicle interior
and extender itself.
Seat Belt Extender
When not in use, remove the extender and store in the vehicle for future use.
Page 6 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’98 – ’00 – BO002–00
January 21, 2000
SEAT BELT EXTENDER WORKSHEET
PLEASE COPY THIS ORIGINAL WORKSHEET FOR EACH EXTENDER NEEDED
CAUTIONS:
S To minimize the chance and/or severity of injury in an accident, the seat belt
extender must only be used:
1 By the person for whom it was provided
2 In the seat position for which it was provided
S The seat belt extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
S When the seat belt extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic
locking retractor), make sure the retractor is locked when extender belt is in use.
DEALER
DEALER CODE
SEAT BELT EXTENDER APPLICATION
DEALER NAME
APPLICANT
APPLICANT NAME
ADDRESS
ADDRESS
CITY & STATE
EMPLOYEE NAME
MODEL YEAR
ZIP
CITY & STATE
BODY TYPE
SEATING POSITION
ZIP
PHONE
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
DIRECTIONS FOR DETERMINING PROPER EXTENDER LENGTH
1.
2.
S
S
S
3.
4.
5.
6.
Place the seat in the position the applicant normally uses
With applicant in the seat, wearing thickest coat expected to be worn, pull belt all the way out and try to buckle
belt
If the belt latches into buckle and feels comfortable against upper chest area, an extender is not needed.
If belt does not buckle continue with step 3
If buckle latches but belt has no slack remaining, continue with step 3
Measure distance between applicant’s navel and seat belt buckle (dimension A) and enter on worksheet
With belt all the way out, measure distance between latch tip and buckle tip (dimension B) and enter on
worksheet
NOTE: If belt latches but there is no slack enter zero as dimension B
Subtract dimension B from dimension A and record number in check number box on worksheet
Seat belt extender length is dimension B rounded up to next extender length (without exceeding check number)
NOTE: If extender length exceeds check number, an extender can not be provided to the
customer
Dimension A:
NAVEL TO BUCKLE
Dimension B:
LATCH TO BUCKLE
Latch
Navel
Buckle
Buckle
A
B
SEAT BELT EXTENDER CALCULATION
DIMENSION A:
DIMENSION B:
CHECK NUMBER:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER AUTHORIZATION
S The same seat belt extender can be used for right and left seating applications. Each seat belt extender will have
a label identifying the owner, VIN and seating position. Seat belt extenders are available only in black.
S Applicant’s Signature: _________________________________________
Date: ______________________
(Actual user of seat belt extender)
Page 7 of 7
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SEAT BELT EXTENDER
Models:
’99 – ’01 Model Year
January 26, 2001
TSB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates BO020–00 dated August 11, 2000.
Revised text is red and underlined.
Introduction
Toyota customers who find it necessary to
increase the length of their seat belts may obtain
Seat Belt Extenders at no cost through their local
Toyota dealer.
Seat Belt
S The extender is available in 6 inch,
9 inch, 12 inch, 15 inch and 18 inch lengths.
S The extender is available only in black.
Extender
S Owners are informed of the Seat Belt Extender
availability through the Toyota Owner’s Manual
included in each vehicle.
The customer (individual requiring the extender) must visit a Toyota dealership to have
the required measurements made and to complete the Seat Belt Extender worksheet.
The worksheet will allow the proper fitting and selection of a Seat Belt Extender for the
customer. The dealership personnel should then determine the applicable part number
and place a Critical Order through the TDN Parts Network.
The dealership service department should complete the affixed Seat Belt Extender
Customer Information Label and review the “Owner Instruction Sheet” with the customer.
The dealership should give a copy of the completed worksheet to the customer and keep
the original in the customer’s file.
To assure utmost owner satisfaction, it is recommended that a dealership designate one
person to coordinate all activities related to the Seat Belt Extender issue.
It is recommended that dealerships do not stock Seat Belt Extenders due to the need
for proper fitting to individual customers.
This bulletin contains the following information:
Procedure and Sample Label . . . . . . . . . . Page 2
Application Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pages 3–4
Part Number Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 5
Owner Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page 6
Seat Belt Extender Worksheet . . . . . . . . . Page 7
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 1999 through 2001 model year Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 7
BODY
BO002-01
Title:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99–’01 MODEL YEAR – BO002-01
Procedure
January 26, 2001
1. Owner requests a Seat Belt Extender from dealer.
2. Dealer verifies the need for a Seat Belt Extender and obtains a current copy of this
TSB and copies the Worksheet.
3. Dealer measures the customer and completes the Worksheet. Dealer determines the
correct part number and places a Critical Order for the part through the TDN Parts
Network.
4. Dealer receives Seat Belt Extender and calls the customer in to check fit of the part.
5. If the Seat Belt Extender fit is good, dealership personnel completes the Customer
Information Label on the part, explains usage of the part, and gives the customer a
copy of the completed Worksheet.
6. Dealer places copy of the completed Worksheet in the customer’s records.
DEALER
MEASURE
CUSTOMER
&
COMPLETE
WORKSHEET
PLACE
CRITICAL
ORDER
THROUGH
TDN
PARTS
SUPPLY
SHIP SEAT
BELT
EXTENDER
TO DEALER
DEALER
TEST FIT
CUSTOMER
WITH PART
COMPLETE
LABEL AND
ADVISE
OWNER
DEALER
RECEIVE
COPY OF
WORKSHEET
& USE
EXTENDER
FILE
WORKSHEET
IN
CUSTOMER
RECORDS
Sample Seat
Belt Extender
Customer
Information
Label
CAUTION
THIS SEAT BELT EXTENDER IS TO BE USED ONLY BY:
ON VEHICLE:
VIN:
SEATING POSITION:
USE BY OTHERS, OR IN ANOTHER SEATING POSITION, OR IN ANOTHER VEHICLE
COULD REDUCE SEAT BELT RESTRAINT IN AN ACCIDENT AND RESULT IN
PERSONAL INJURY.
Page 2 of 7
Front Seat
Belt Extender
Applications
FRONT SEAT – EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
’01
’00
’99
RAV4
–
R–5
R–5
R–5
ECHO
–
K–5
K–5
–
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
COROLLA
TMMC PRODUCTION
NUMMI PRODUCTION
PRIUS
–
N–7
–
–
MR2 SPYDER
–
N–6
N–6
–
LIFTBACK & COUPE
N–6
N–6
CONVERTIBLE
–
–
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
CELICA
CAMRY
CAMRY SOLARA
TMC PRODUCTION
TMMK PRODUCTION
COUPE
CONVERTIBLE
N–6
Q–4
Q–4
–
AVALON*
–
T–1
T–1
Q–2
SIENNA
–
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
TACOMA*
–
S–2
S–1
S–1
4RUNNER
–
K–5
K–5
K–5
LAND CRUISER
–
K–5
K–5
K–5
SEQUOIA
–
Q–4
–
–
TUNDRA*
–
Q–4
Q–4
–
HIGHLANDER
–
R–5
–
–
* The extender must not be used for the center seat of Avalon, Tacoma, and Tundra which have bench seats.
Page 3 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99–’01 MODEL YEAR – BO002-01
Rear Seat
Belt Extender
Applications
REAR SEAT – EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
RAV4
TYPE
’01
’00
’99
W/TOKAI RIKA
R–5
R–5*1
R–5*1
W/QSS
–
Q–4*2
Q–4*2
–
R–5
R–5
–
TMMC PRODUCTION
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
NUMMI PRODUCTION
T–1
T–1
T–1
–
N–7
–
–
LIFTBACK & COUPE
N–6
N–6
N–6
–
–
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
ECHO
COROLLA
PRIUS
CELICA
CONVERTIBLE (RH)
CONVERTIBLE (LH)
CAMRY
CAMRY SOLARA
TMC PRODUCTION
TMMK PRODUCTION
COUPE
CONVERTIBLE
N–1
N–5
Q–4
Q–4
–
AVALON
–
T–1
T–1
Q–2
SIENNA
–
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
TACOMA
XTRACAB
A–2
A–2
A–2
4RUNNER
–
R–5
R–5
R–5
LAND CRUISER
–
K–5
K–5
K–5
REAR SEAT #1
T–1
REAR SEAT #2
Q–4
–
–
TUNDRA
ACCESS CAB
Q–4
Q–4
–
HIGHLANDER
–
R–5
–
–
SEQUOIA
*1
This seat belt was supplied by TOKAI
RIKA. Make sure that the I/D mark on
the back side of the seat belt buckle
is the same as shown.
*2
This seat belt was supplied by QSS.
Make sure that the I/D mark on the
back side of the seat belt buckle is
the same as shown.
NOTE:
The seat belt extender must not be
used for the center rear seat belt.
Page 4 of 7
January 26, 2001
Part Number
Information
PART NUMBER PREFIX: 73399–
SERIES
LENGTH
6 INCH
9 INCH
12 INCH
15 INCH
18 INCH
R–5
–16060
–16070
–16080
–16090
–16100
N–1
–12060
–12070
–12080
–12090
–12100
N–5
–20110
–20120
–20130
–20140
–20150
N–6
–20160
–20170
–20180
–20190
–20200
N–7
–47010
–47020
–47030
–47040
–47050
K–5
–35010
–35020
–35030
–35040
–25050
A–2
–01060*
–01070
–01080
–01090
–01100
Q–2
–06010
–06020
–06030
–06040
–06050
Q–4
–0W010
–0W020
–0W030
–0W040
–0W050
S–1
–04010
–04020
–04030
–04040
–04050
S–2
–04060
–04070
–04080
–04090
–04100
T–1
–01110
–01120
–01130
–01140
–01150
* Length: 7-1/4”
Page 5 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99–’01 MODEL YEAR – BO002-01
Owner
Instructions
January 26, 2001
Failure to follow the recommendations indicated below could result in reduced
effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in case of vehicle collision, causing
personal injury.
The Seat Belt Extender must not be used:
a. By anyone other than for whom it was provided (name recorded on seat belt
extender).
b. In any vehicle and/or seat position other than the one for which it was provided.
c. When the Seat Belt Extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic
locking retractor), make sure the retractor is locked when in use.
If your seat belt cannot be fastened securely because it is not long enough, a
personalized Seat Belt Extender is available from your Toyota dealer free of charge.
Please contact your local Toyota dealer so that the dealer can order the proper required
length for the extender. Bring the heaviest coat you expect to wear for proper
measurement and selection of length. Additional ordering information is available at your
Toyota dealer.
CAUTION:
When using the Seat Belt Extender, observe the following. Failure to follow these
instructions could result in reduced effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in
case of vehicle accident, increasing the chance of personal injury.
S Never use the Seat Belt Extender if you can COMFORTABLY fasten the seat belt
without it.
S The Seat Belt Extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
S Remember that the extender provided for you may not be safe when used on a
different vehicle, or for another person or at a different seating position than the
one originally intended for.
To connect the extender to the seat
belt, insert the tab into the seat belt
buckle so that the “PRESS” signs on
the buckle-release buttons of the
extender and the seat belt are both
facing outward as shown.
Seat Belt Release
You will hear a click when the tab locks
into the buckle.
When releasing the seat belt, press on
the buckle-release button on the
extender, not on the seat belt. This helps
prevent damage to the vehicle interior
and extender itself.
When not in use, remove the extender
and store in the vehicle for future use.
Page 6 of 7
Seat Belt Extender
PLEASE COPY THIS ORIGINAL WORKSHEET FOR EACH EXTENDER NEEDED
CAUTIONS:
S To minimize the chance and/or severity of injury in an accident, the Seat Belt Extender must only be used:
1 By the person for whom it was provided.
2 In the seat position for which it was provided.
S The Seat Belt Extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
S When the Seat Belt Extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic locking retractor),
make sure the retractor is locked when extender belt is in use.
DEALER
DEALER CODE
SEAT BELT EXTENDER APPLICATION
DEALER NAME
ADDRESS
ADDRESS
CITY & STATE
EMPLOYEE NAME
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
APPLICANT
APPLICANT NAME
MODEL YEAR
ZIP
CITY & STATE
ZIP
BODY TYPE
SEATING POSITION
PHONE
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
DIRECTIONS FOR DETERMINING PROPER EXTENDER LENGTH
Place the seat in the position the applicant normally uses.
With the applicant in the seat, wearing the thickest coat expected to be worn, pull belt all the way out
and try to buckle belt.
S If belt latches into buckle and feels comfortable against upper chest area, an extender is not needed.
S If belt does not buckle, continue with Step 3.
S If buckle latches but belt has no slack remaining, continue with Step 3.
Measure distance between applicant’s navel and seat belt buckle (Dimension A) and enter on Worksheet.
With belt all the way out, measure distance between latch tip and buckle tip (Dimension B) and enter
on Worksheet.
NOTE: If belt latches but there is no slack enter zero as Dimension B.
Subtract Dimension B from Dimension A and record number in Check Number box on Worksheet.
Seat Belt Extender length is Dimension B rounded up to next extender length (without exceeding
Check Number).
NOTE: If extender length exceeds Check Number, an extender cannot be provided to the customer.
Dimension A:
NAVEL TO BUCKLE
Dimension B:
LATCH TO BUCKLE
Latch
Navel
Buckle
A
B
Buckle
SEAT BELT EXTENDER CALCULATION
DIMENSION A:
DIMENSION B:
CHECK NUMBER:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER AUTHORIZATION
S The same Seat Belt Extender can be used for right and left seating applications. Each Seat Belt
Extender will have a label identifying the owner, VIN and seating position. Seat Belt Extenders are
available only in black.
S Applicant’s Signature:
(Actual user of seat belt extender)
Date:
Page 7 of 7
Models:
All Models
February 21, 1997
Introduction
Affected
Vehicles
Parts
Information
A kit containing special foam sponge material has been developed. This kit, when used
in conjunction with procedures outlined in the Wind Noise Service Information book
(P/N 00401–42978), specific Service Tips and Technical Service Bulletins, should enable
effective wind noise repairs.
D
All Models
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
SIZE (MM)
QTY
08231–00810
Kit, Wind Noise
–––
1
08231–00811 *
Caulking Sponge Sealant No. 1
297 x 150 (T = 3.0)
2
08231–00812 *
Caulking Sponge Sealant No .2
297 x 150 (T = 5.0)
2
08231–00813 *
Caulking Sponge Sealant No. 3
297 x 150 (T = 10.0)
2
08231–00814 *
Caulking Sponge Sealant No. 4
297 x 150 (T = 3.0)
2
08231–00815 *
Caulking Sponge Sealant No. 5
297 x 150 (T = 5.0)
2
08231–00816 *
Caulking Sponge Sealant No. 6
297 x 150 (T = 5.0)
2
* All of these parts are included in the kit.
Kit
Components
1. Caulking Sponge Sealant No. 1, No. 2
and No. 3 (Ept–sealer).
With adhesive tape
2. Caulking Sponge Sealant No. 4 and
No. 5 (Ept–sealer). This sheet is
divided into 27 strips, 5 mm wide.
With adhesive tape
3. Caulking Sponge Sealant No. 6
(Ept–sealer).
With adhesive tape
Page 1 of 1
BODY
TSB
WIND NOISE REPAIR KIT
BO003-97
Title:
CAMRY CENTER CONSOLE LATCH
IMPROVEMENTS
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’97–’99 Camry
March 26, 1999
Introduction
Affected
Vehicles
The center console compartment door has been changed to improve the durability of the
console box latch.
S 1997 – 1999 Camrys produced before VIN:
4T1BG ** K * XU414881 (L4)
4T1BF ** K * XU076659 (V6)
4T1BG ** K * XU867323 (L4)
4T1BF ** K * XU930092 (V6)
Parts
Information
Repair
Procedure
PREVIOUS PART #
CURRENT PART #
PART NAME
58910–AA010–XX
58910–AA011–XX
Console Box Assembly
58905–AA010–XX
58905–AA011–XX
Console Compartment Door
S On vehicles produced before the production change, replace the Rear Console Box
with P/N 58910–AA011–XX. Refer to Repair Manual, page BO–72 for detailed repair
procedures.
NOTE:
On vehicles produced after the production change, replace the console compartment
door only. These vehicles can be identified by a metal hinge on the console
compartment door.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
743641
R & R Rear Console Box Assembly
0.3
58910–AA010–XX
54 12
743931
R & R Rear Console Compartment Door
0.2
58905–AA010–XX
54 12
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
BODY
BO005–99
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
April 16, 1999
Introduction
Affected
Vehicles
TMMK CAMRY/SIENNA HEADLIGHT
ALIGNMENT
Models:
’97–’99 Camry, ’98–’99 Sienna
To enhance headlamp performance on dark roads, the headlamp alignment process has
been modified.
S 1997–1999 TMMK Camrys produced before the following VINs:
Camry (4–Cyl)
4T1BG2 * K * XU453367
Camry (V–6)
4T1BF2 * K * XU079094
Camry (4–Cyl)
4T1BG2 * K * XU877828
Camry (V–6)
4T1BF2 * K * XU930732
S 1998–1999 Siennas produced before the following VIN:
Sienna
4T3ZF13C * XU119213
Required
Tools and
Material
Headlight Aiming Device.
Repair
Procedure
Refer to the ’98 Camry Repair Manual
page BE–27. Adjust the headlight
nominal line 1’’ higher. State and Federal
standards apply.
New Nominal
cutline 1’’ up
NOTE:
Vehicle lighting will remain within the
tolerances of all applicable federal and
state regulations.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not applicable to warranty
–
–
–
–
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
BODY
BO007–99
Title:
BODY
BO008–96
AUGUST 9, 1996
ALL MODELS
STAINS ON RAPGARD APPLIED AREAS
Page 1 of 1
On some Toyota models, when Rapgard is removed from the vehicle, a stain is left on the paint
surface. This stain can be seen under the clear coat and is not a defect of the clear coat. The
stain corresponds to a wrinkled area of Rapgard which retained liquids, such as window washer
fluid, that left a discoloration.
Stain
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
To remove a stain from a vehicle, heat the stain surface to a temperature of 70_C – 80_C.
When the stain is removed it will not reappear.
Equipment –
1. Infrared lamp or dryer to heat the surface.
2. Aluminum foil or a damp cloth to protect plastic parts from deformation.
Procedure –
1. Apply aluminum foil to adjoining plastic parts or cool with damp cloth periodically.
2. Use an infrared lamp or dryer on the stain developed area and heat for 5 to 10 minutes
at 70_C – 80_C.
3. After heating for 5 minutes, check whether the stain has disappeared. If the stain still
remains, reheat the area and check again.
NOTE:
Take care that the body’s paint surface temperature does not become too high.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
OPCODE
BD6004
DESCRIPTION
Remove stains from paint surface
caused by Rapguard
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
0.6
53301–XXXXX
61
99
Technical Service
BULLETIN
April 28, 2000
LOOSE CENTER HVAC VENT
ADJUSTMENT
Models:
’98 – ’99 CBU Camry
TSB Revision Notice:
The information updated in this TSB is red and underlined.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Production
Change
Information
Parts
Information
Repair
Procedure
A repair procedure has been made available to remedy customer complaints regarding
loose vertical adjustment of the center vents on 1998 – 1999 CBU Camry.
S 1998 through 1999 model year Japan built Camry.
MODEL/PLANT
STARTING VIN
JT2BG2*K*X0339018
2000 MY Japan Built Camry
JT2BF2*K*X0200364
PART NUMBER
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
90202–05129
Washer
2
1. Remove the left vent barrel by gently
prying using a wide flat tool with
smooth edges. Be careful not to
damage the vent assembly.
2. Install a washer (P/N 90202–05129)
on the shaft inside the vent duct.
3. Reinstall the vent barrel by carefully
pushing it into position until it locks
onto the shafts on the sides of the
duct. Be sure the spacer and/or
washer do not fall down into the vent
duct.
Vent Duct
Center Vent Assembly
Install Washer (P/N 90202–05129)
on Shaft Inside Vent Duct
Vent Barrel
Install
Spacer
Here
NOTE:
The spacer (P/N 55682–12140) can be
ordered, if lost.
4. Confirm that the vent vertical
adjustment is tighter and moves
smoothly.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for the right
center vent.
Warranty
Information
Spacer
(P/N 55682–12140)
Side View of Vent Barrel
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
BD0025
Remove & Reinstall Vent Barrels
0.2
55660–33080–XX
T1
T2
40 14
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
BODY
BO009–00
Title:
BODY
BO010–96
NOVEMBER 22, 1986
CAM
1997 CAMRY DOOR MIRROR INSTALLATION
Page 1 of 2
The following procedures explain in detail how to install the 1997 Camry Door Mirrors.
CAUTION: Should the door mirror be installed incorrectly, a wind noise (air leakage noise)
might be generated.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURES:
1. Remove the retaining clip and tweeter (if
applicable) from the door. Discard the
removed clip.
Clip
Tweeter
2. In order to secure the door mirror to the
correct position, insert the 2 pins of the
door mirror base into the holes of the
door.
Pins
3. Push the door mirror against the door
and check that the door mirror base
edge is in contact with the door frame
molding lip.
NOTE:
This area is critical to wind noise
reduction.
Molding Lip
Mirror Base
1997 CAMRY DOOR MIRROR INSTALLATION
Page 2 of 2
INSTALLATION PROCEDURES (Cont’d):
4. Tighten the three mirror mounting nuts A , B
and C for vehicles without a tweeter.
B
C
Torque: 5.5 N.m (56 kgf.cm, 49 in.lbf)
A
Connect the mirror wire.
5. Tighten the two mirror mounting nuts A and
B for vehicles with a tweeter.
B
Torque: 5.5 N.m (56 kgf.cm, 49 in.lbf)
A
Connect the mirror wire.
While lightly pulling the mirror wire
backward, install the tweeter and tighten
nut C.
C
Torque: 5.5 N.m (56 kgf.cm, 49 in.lbf)
NOTE:
Check that the mirror wire is free
from the tweeter bracket.
6. Check the following items:
D
D
There is no clearance between the door
mirror base and the door molding lip.
The door frame molding lip is not tucked
under the mirror base.
Molding Lip
Mirror Base
7. Install the front door lower frame bracket
garnish.
8. Install the black cap onto the nut.
Garnish
Cap
Technical Service
BULLETIN
May 24, 2002
Introduction
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP
BRACKET INSTALLATION
Models:
’83 – ’00 All Models
Child restraint seat top strap bracket installation procedures are provided to supplement
the Owner’s Manual. Beginning with 2001 models, the top strap brackets are factory
installed.
NOTE:
S The child restraint seat top strap assembly is not available as a service part.
Contact the child restraint seat manufacturer for recommended top strap information,
top strap to child restraint seat installation instructions, and top strap retailers.
S The top strap brackets can only be installed on vehicles that have nuts welded in
place by the factory. The locations of these nuts can be found in the Owner’s Manual
(for most 1983 and newer models.) Toyota does not recommend modifying vehicles
that do not have nuts welded in place by the factory. Some Land Cruiser and RAV4
vehicles, prior to 2001 model year, may not have these nuts welded in by the factory.
Top Strap
Top Strap Bracket
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
S 1983 – 2000 model year vehicles, all models.
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
73709–12010
Bracket Sub–Assembly (Bracket, Bolt, 10 mm Spacer, and Washers)
04731–22012
CRS Kit (two Bolts [15 mm, 30 mm],
three Spacers [5 mm, 10 mm, 15 mm], and Locking Clip)
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 9
BODY
BO010-02
Title:
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP BRACKET INSTALLATION – BO010-02
Installation
Procedure
May 24, 2002
Child Restraint Seat Top Strap Bracket Installation
Obtain the exact year and vehicle model Toyota Owner’s Manual before beginning
installation.
1. Confirm with the customer which seat
location(s) they will be installing the
child restraint seat. The Owner’s
Manual seat section provides an
illustration showing available top strap
bracket location(s). The illustration
page in the Owner’s Manual is
provided in pages 4–9 of this bulletin.
NOTE:
Determine which kit parts are needed
for each specific child seat location, by
referring to pages 4–9 of this bulletin.
Bolt
Anchor
Bracket
345 mm
(13.6 in.)
Spacer
100 mm
(4.0 in.)
185 mm
(7.3 in.)
Example of 1999 Camry Showing Three (3)
Available Bracket Locations
2. Remove a 20 mm diameter area of
the carpet or trim material above the
bracket mounting location. In some
vehicles, a 20 mm circle is already
pre–cut into the interior trim material.
Once the interior trim material is
removed, the nuts welded in by the
factory should be visible.
Example of Pre–Cut Circle in Package Tray Finisher
3. If a 5 mm or 15 mm spacer is
specified, remove the red lock washer
from the Bracket Sub–Assembly
(P/N 73709–12010) and remove the
10 mm spacer. Assure the red lock
washer is re–installed onto the bolt.
If a 5 mm spacer is needed, use the
15 mm bolt from the CRS Kit
(P/N 04731–22012).
Bolt
Wave Washer
Bracket
Nylon Washer
Spacer
(5/10/15 mm)
Red Lock Washer
Page 2 of 9
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP BRACKET INSTALLATION – BO010-02
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
4. Install the bracket assembly,
according to the directions in the
Owner’s Manual. Tighten the bolt to
16.5 – 24.7 N–m, (1.68 – 2.52 kgf–m,
12.2 – 18.2 ft–lbf).
May 24, 2002
Top Strap Installed
S Assure the top strap is attached
to the child seat, according to the
child seat manufacturer’s
instructions.
Bracket
Assembly
Installed
Body
Nut Welded
in Place
S Assure the child seat is installed
in the vehicle according to the
Toyota Owner’s Manual (seat
section).
Installation
Reference
Information
Owner’s Manual Installation Reference Information
The following pages of this bulletin contain a reference information chart. This chart
contains:
S Owner’s Manual page(s) that provide the illustration showing available top strap
bracket location(s). The information goes back to 1983 model year. 2001 models
and newer already had the bracket installed by the factory.
S Installation notes, such as bracket spacer sizes for each specific child seat location.
EXAMPLE:
This cell contains information on the 2000 4Runner
OWNER’S
MANUAL
4Runner
2000
pg 73
a
Refer to this page in the Owner’s Manual to find the illustration showing
available top strap bracket locations.
Installation Note. In this case, all bracket positions on the 2000 4Runner
will require a 15 mm spacer.
INSTALLATION NOTE
COMMENT
a
Spacer – 15 mm for all anchors
b
Spacer – 10 mm for outer, 15 mm for center
c
Spacer – 15 mm for outer, 10 mm for center
d
Spacer – 5 mm for all anchors
e
Spacer – 15 mm for outer, none for center
f
Spacer – 15 mm for center, none for outer
g
No Spacer
h
Spacer – 10 mm for all anchors
i
Bolt for All–Trac/4WD only (Part No. 91511–60814) (Celica & Previa)
NP
Spacer pictured but no specifications
N/A
Top strap anchor bracket mounting not available
Standard
No installation necessary, anchor already installed by factory
Page 3 of 9
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP BRACKET INSTALLATION – BO010-02
Installation
Reference
Information
(Continued)
OWNER’S
MANUAL
4Runner
Avalon
Camry
Sedan
2000
pg 73
a
Standard
Standard
Standard
1999
pg 71
a
pg 72
a
pg 71–73
a
pg 68
a
1998
pg 53
a
pg 70
a
pg 68–69
a
pg 48
a
1997
pg 52
a
pg 52
a
pg 56–57
a
pg 45
a
1996
pg 45
NP
pg 40
a
pg 47
a
pg 48
a
pg 37
a
1995
pg 31
g
pg 39
a
pg 44–45
a
pg 45
a
pg 36
a
1994
pg 29
g
pg 41–42
a
pg 42
a
pg 31
a
1993
pg 26
g
pg 33
a
pg
33–34
a
Camry
Solara
Camry
Wagon
Celica All
Trac 4WD
Celica
Coupe
1992
pg 26
g
pg 27
a
1991
pg 27
g
pg 29
c
1990
pg 27
g
1989
pg 49
a
pg 30
i, g
pg 29
a
pg 30
i, g
pg 29
a
pg 29
g
pg 29–30
i, g
pg 29
a
pg 29
c
pg 29
g
pg 29–30
i, g
pg 29
a
pg
31–33
g
pg 32
c
pg 33
g
pg 29–30
i, g
pg 31
a
1988
pg
19–20
g
pg 32
b
pg 32
g
pg 16
i, g
pg 16
a
1987
pg 18
g
pg 15
b
pg 16
g
1986
pg 17
g
pg 13
e
pg 14
f
pg 12
a
1985
pg 16
g
pg 13
e
pg 13
f
pg 12
a
1984
pg
15–16
g
pg 13
e
pg 13
f
pg 12
a
pg 12–13
e
pg 13
f
pg 11–12
a
1983
Page 4 of 9
Camry
Liftback
May 24, 2002
pg 13
a
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP BRACKET INSTALLATION – BO010-02
Installation
Reference
Information
(Continued)
Corolla
FWD
Liftback
Corolla
4WD
Wagon
May 24, 2002
Corolla
RWD
2–Door
Coupe
OWNER’S
MANUAL
Celica
Liftback
Corolla
FWD
Sedan
2000
Standard
Standard
1999
pg 49
a
pg 67
a
1998
pg
49–50
a
pg 65
a
1997
pg
46–47
a
pg 61
h
1996
pg
37–38
a
pg 49
h
1995
pg
37–38
a
pg 43
h
1994
pg 32
a
pg 39
h
1993
pg 30
g
pg 32–33
h
1992
pg 30
g
pg 34
h
pg 34
g
1991
pg
29–30
g
pg 44
h
pg 45
g
pg 45
a
1990
pg
29–30
g
pg 44–45
h
pg 46
g
pg 45
a
1989
pg 31
g
pg 40
h
pg 41–42
g
pg 41
a
1988
pg 16
g
pg 21–22
h
1987
pg 13
g
pg 13–14
a
pg 14
f
pg 12
h
1986
pg 13
g
pg 12
a
pg 12
f
pg 12
h
1985
pg 13
g
pg 13
a
pg 14
f
pg 12
h
1984
pg 12
g
pg 12–13
a
pg 13
f
pg 12
h
1983
pg 12
g
pg 10
a
pg 11
g
Corolla
Coupe
pg 22
a
pg 11
g
Corolla
FX/FX16
Corolla
Hardtop
pg 26
f
pg 10
h
Page 5 of 9
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP BRACKET INSTALLATION – BO010-02
Installation
Reference
Information
(Continued)
OWNER’S
MANUAL
Corolla
RWD
3–Door
Coupe
Corolla
Wagon
Cressida
Cressida
Wagon
2000
Echo
Land
Cruiser
Standard
N/A
MR2
Paseo
Coupe &
Convert.
1999
N/A
pg 63
a
1998
N/A
pg 61
a
1997
N/A
pg 55
a
pg 40
h
1996
pg 49–50
h
N/A
1995
pg 44
h
N/A
pg 38
a
pg 37
h
1994
pg 40
h
N/A
pg 33
a
pg 33
h
1993
pg 33
h
N/A
pg 31
a
pg 31
h
1992
pg 35
h
pg 29
c
N/A
pg 31
a
pg 27
h
1991
pg 46
h
pg 29
c
N/A
pg 31
a
1990
pg 46–47
g
pg 30
c
N/A
1989
pg 42
a
pg 34
c
N/A
pg 28
a
1988
pg 23
h
pg 30
h
N/A
pg 12
a
1987
pg 13
g
pg 21
h
pg 21
g
N/A
pg 11
a
1986
pg 12
g
pg 16
h
pg 16
g
N/A
pg 11
a
1985
pg 11
g
pg 15–16
h
pg 16
g
N/A
pg 11
a
1984
pg 11
g
pg 15
g
pg 15
g
N/A
pg 15
g
pg 15
g
N/A
1983
Page 6 of 9
May 24, 2002
pg 11
g
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP BRACKET INSTALLATION – BO010-02
Installation
Reference
Information
(Continued)
OWNER’S
MANUAL
Previa
RAV4
RAV EV
Sienna
2000
N/A
Standard
pg 99
a
1999
N/A
N/A
pg 96
a
1998
N/A
Starlet
pg 74
a
May 24, 2002
Supra
T100 Ext.
Cab 2WD
T100 Ext.
Cab 4WD
pg 49
d
N/A
N/A
1997
pg 60
a
N/A
pg 49
d
N/A
N/A
1996
pg
47–48
a
N/A
pg 36
d
N/A
N/A
1995
pg
46–47
a
pg 36–37
d
N/A
N/A
1994
pg
41–42
a
pg 32–33
d
1993
pg
41–42
a
pg 32–33
d
1992
pg
37–38
i
pg 32
h
1991
pg
33–34
i
pg 33
h
1990
pg 31
h
1989
pg 31
h
1988
pg 32
h
1987
pg 15
h
1986
pg 13–14
g
1985
pg 13
g
1984
pg 9
g
pg 12
g
1983
pg 9
g
pg 11
g
Page 7 of 9
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP BRACKET INSTALLATION – BO010-02
Installation
Reference
Information
(Continued)
OWNER’S
MANUAL
T100 Reg
Cab 4WD
T100 Reg
Cab 2WD
Tacoma
2000
N/A
1999
N/A
1998
N/A
N/A
N/A
1997
N/A
N/A
N/A
1996
N/A
N/A
N/A
1995
N/A
N/A
N/A
1994
N/A
N/A
1993
N/A
N/A
Tercel
2 Door
Tercel 4WD
Wagon
May 24, 2002
Tercel 3/5
Tercel 4WD
Tercel All
Models
1992
1991
Page 8 of 9
1990
pg 31
a
pg 31
h
1989
pg 30–31
a
pg 30
h
1988
pg 18
a, d
pg 17
h
1987
pg 12
g
pg 12
g
1986
pg 12
g
pg 12
g
1985
pg 11–13
g
1984
pg 11
g
1983
pg 11
g
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT TOP STRAP BRACKET INSTALLATION – BO010-02
Installation
Reference
Information
(Continued)
OWNER’S
MANUAL
Tercel Sedan/
Coupe
Tercel Wagon
Truck 2x4
Truck 4x4
2000
May 24, 2002
Tundra
Van
Standard
1999
pg 60
h
1998
pg 59
h
1997
pg 54
h
1996
pg 41
h
1995
pg 38
h
1994
pg 39
h
pg 32
g
pg 32
g
1993
pg 35
h
pg 27
g
pg 27
g
1992
pg 29
h
pg 27
g
pg 27
g
1991
pg 28
h
pg 26
g
pg 26
g
1990
pg 26
g
pg 26
g
1989
pg 29
g
pg 29
g
pg 37
a
1988
pg 13
g
pg 19
g
pg 23
a
1987
pg 12
g
pg 11
g
pg 14
g
pg 18
g
pg 21
a
1986
pg 12
g
pg 12
g
pg 13
g
pg 17
g
pg 20
a
1985
pg 12
g
pg 15
g
pg 17
a
1984
pg 12
g
pg 12
g
pg 17
a
1983
N/A
N/A
Page 9 of 9
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 23, 2001
Introduction
All Applicable Models
MODEL
YEAR
Avalon
1995 – 2001
Camry
1983 – 2001
Corolla
1980 – 2001
Camry Solara
1999 – 2001
Sienna (Front Seat Belt Only)
1998 – 2001
RAV4
1997 – 2001
4Runner
1992 – 2001
Land Cruiser
1991 – 2001
Tundra
2000 – 2001
Tacoma
1997 – 2000
ECHO
2000 – 2001
Celica
1980 – 2001
Prius
2001
Tercel
1981 – 1999
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
N/A
73219–02010
Stopper, Tongue Plate (Black)*
N/A
73219–02020
Stopper, Tongue Plate (Gray)*
N/A
73219–02030
Stopper, Tongue Plate (Beige)*
*
Warranty
Information
Models:
A new service part for the seat belt tongue plate stopper has been introduced.
Installation procedures are provided to supplement the Repair Manual.
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
NEW SEAT BELT TONGUE PLATE
STOPPER SERVICE PARTS
Use a stopper color that is closest to the seat belt webbing color.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
BD0047
Install Seat Belt Tongue Plate Stopper
0.1
73219–020#0
T1
T2
62 12
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is
in effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
BODY
BO011–01
Title:
NEW SEAT BELT TONGUE PLATE STOPPER SERVICE PARTS – BO011–01
Installation
Procedure
1. Preparation
A. Shift the Tongue Plate to the
upper portion of the Tongue Plate
Stopper, and temporarily hold it
with a clip or tape.
B. Remove any pieces of the original
Tongue Plate Stopper in the
webbing, with a pair of pliers.
CAUTION:
Damaged or weakened seat belts may
break in an accident and injure the
occupant. The seat belt assembly must
be replaced if:
S The webbing is cut, frayed, worn, or
damaged.
S It has been used in a severe impact.
Inspect the entire length of webbing
for damage and replace the assembly
if needed. Be careful not to damage
the webbing during repair.
Tongue
Plate
March 23, 2001
Tape
Example of
Broken Tongue
Plate Stopper
2. Install the New Tongue Plate Stopper
A. Install a new Tongue Plate
Stopper in the hole of the
webbing.
NOTE:
Be aware of the installation direction
of the Tongue Plate Stopper as shown
in the illustration.
Tongue Plate
Stopper
B. Pinch the Tongue Plate Stopper
into the webbing using an
adjustable wrench, and turn and
push the adjustment screw by
hand.
HINT:
Press the adjustment screw in order to
position the male and female parts of
the Tongue Plate Stopper parallel to
each other, as shown in illustration.
CAUTION:
DO NOT use pliers. They may damage
the webbing.
Page 2 of 3
Webbing
NEW SEAT BELT TONGUE PLATE STOPPER SERVICE PARTS – BO011–01
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
March 23, 2001
C. When the adjustment screw for
the adjustable wrench can’t be
turned by hand, tighten the
adjustment screw using a pair of
adjustable joint pliers until the
space between jaws of the
adjustable wrench is 4.5 – 5.0 mm.
(See illustrations.)
4.5 – 5.0 mm
D. Check to be sure that the male
pin of the Tongue Plate Stopper
has become deformed evenly in
the hole of the female part and is
firmly held to the belt webbing.
(See illustrations.)
CORRECT
INCORRECT
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
DOOR GLASS DISPLACEMENT FIELD FIX
Models:
’98 – ’99 TMMK Camry
September 3, 1999
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
On some 1998 and 1999 Camry Vehicles, the door glass may be displaced from the front
door glass run if the door is closed forcefully with the windows partially down. A field fix
has been developed in order to remedy this condition.
S 1998 – 1999 TMMK Camrys built before 4T1BG * * K * XU553205
4T1BF * * K * XU084313
4T1BG * * K * XU903993
4T1BF * * K * XU932180
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
N/A
67212–AA010
Self–Adhesive Stopper
OP CODE
670301
COMBO
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
A
R&R Door Trim/Install Rubber Stopper
– Both Sides
0.5
67402–AA011
T1
T2
53 57
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
BODY
BO012–99
Title:
DOOR GLASS DISPLACEMENT FIELD FIX – BO012–99
Repair
Procedure
September 3, 1999
Refer to 1998 Camry Repair Manual (Vol. 2) Pages BO–11–14.
1. Remove the front door trim to gain access to the window components.
2. Inspect the front and rear lower frames and the door glass run for damage as a result
of the glass being displaced.
S In cases of slight deformation of window frames, reform as necessary.
If significantly deformed or damaged, replace the frame.
S Replace the window run if cut, torn, mutilated, etc.
3. Replace any damaged parts.
4. Remove front lower frame from the door and attach the self–adhesive rubber stopper
(P/N 67212–AA010) 120 mm from the top of the frame as shown below.
NOTE:
To insure proper adhesion of the self–adhesive rubber stopper, the surface of the
frame must be cleaned to remove any foreign material.
5. Reinstall the front lower frame, door glass run, and door trim.
Stopper
67212–AA010
(50 x 12 x 4.76 mm)
(double sided tape)
120 mm
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
DOOR MIRROR INSTALLATION
Models:
’97 – ’00 Japan Built Camry
March 24, 2000
Introduction
The procedures in this bulletin explain in detail how to install the door mirrors.
CAUTION:
If the door mirror is installed incorrectly, a wind noise (air leakage noise) might be
generated.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Installation
Procedure
S 1997 – 2000 model year Japan built Camry
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
1. Remove the retaining clip and
speaker (if applicable) from the door.
Discard the removed clip.
Clip
Speaker
2. In order to secure the door mirror in
the correct position, insert the 2 pins
of the door mirror base into the holes
of the door.
Pins
3. Push the door mirror against the door
and check that the door mirror base
edge is in contact with the door frame
molding lip.
Molding Lip
Mirror Base
NOTE:
This area is critical to wind noise
reduction.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
BODY
BO015–00
Title:
DOOR MIRROR INSTALLATION – BO015-00
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
March 24, 2000
4. For vehicles without a speaker,
tighten the three mirror mounting nuts.
Mounting
Nuts
Torque: 5.5 NSm (56 kgfScm, 49 inSlbf)
Connect the mirror wire.
5. For vehicles with a speaker, tighten
the two mirror mounting nuts.
Mounting
Nuts
Torque: 5.5 NSm (56 kgfScm, 49 inSlbf)
Connect the mirror wire.
Speaker
While lightly pulling the mirror wire
backward, reinstall the door speaker (one
nut at the lower bracket) onto the door as
shown in the illustration.
INCORRECT
CORRECT
Torque: 5.5 NSm (56 kgfScm, 49 inSlbf)
NOTE:
S Do NOT mount the upper speaker
bracket behind the nut.
6. Check the following items:
S There is no clearance between
the door mirror base and the door
molding lip.
S The mirror wire is free from the
speaker bracket.
S The door frame molding lip is not
tucked under the mirror base.
S The speaker wire does not
contact the mirror mounting
screw.
S Make sure the power mirror
adjustment and the door speaker
functions properly.
Mounting Lip
Mirror Base
Speaker Cover
Garnish
7. Install the front door lower frame
bracket garnish/speaker cover.
8. Install the black cap onto the nut.
Cap
Page 2 of 2
POWER SEAT MOTOR CABLE REPAIR TIP
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’99 – ’00 Camry & Solara, ’99 – ’01 Sienna
May 25, 2001
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
June 25, 2003: The Parts Information table has been updated.
The previous TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
A field fix has been developed to repair loose power seat motor cables (instead of seat
adjuster replacement). Loose cables can cause seat movement feel or no movement of
seat adjustment.
S 1999 – 2000 model year Camry and Solara vehicles.
S 1999 – 2001 model year Sienna vehicles.
3M PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QUANTITY
3M 36596
3M EPS–300 Thin–Wall
1 Per Seat Motor
Required
Tools &
Material
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
BD1017
TOOLS & MATERIALS
QUANTITY
Heat Gun
1
DESCRIPTION
R & R Seat Assembly;
Install Shrink Sleeves
TIME
OPN
0.5
72020–06020 (Solara)
72020–AA011 (Camry
72020–08010 (Sienna)
T1
T2
95 15
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
BODY
BO017-01
Title:
POWER SEAT MOTOR CABLE REPAIR TIP – BO017-01 Revised
Repair
Procedure
May 25, 2001
1. Remove the seat assembly from the
vehicle.
Turn the seat over and detach motors
from the mounting brackets.
NOTE:
The lower seat cushion must be
removed from the seat frame to access
the motor mounting screws on some
models.
2. Remove the drive cable from the motor gear boxes. Slide a shrink wrap tube
(3/4” diameter x 1.75”, 3M P/N 36596) on each end of the flex shaft, as shown in
the illustration.
S The Camry and Sienna will require six (6) shrink tubes.
S The Solara will require only one (1) shrink tube.
Front
Camry/Sienna
Solara
3. Attach the drive cables to the motors and reinstall motors to the motor mounts.
4. Position each shrink wrap tube so that it overlaps the drive cable housing and motor
housing or gear box housing, as necessary.
5. Using a heat gun, apply heat to the
shrink tubes in a direction from the
center of the drive cable toward the
gear box or motor housing. Be sure to
apply just enough heat to shrink the
tubing.
6. Reinstall the seat cushion to the seat
frame. Tighten the mounting screws to
torque specifications listed in the BO
section of the Repair Manual.
7. Reinstall the seat assembly to the
floor of the vehicle. Assure all
connectors are secure and the power
seat adjustments properly function.
Torque: 37 NSm, 380 kgfScm, 27 ftSlbs
Page 2 of 2
Heat Gun
Shrink Tube
Technical Service
BULLETIN
TRIM GARNISH LOOSE
Models:
All Models
September 9, 2003
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
March 3, 2004: The TSB has been changed to include new inspection and
replacement instructions.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
Customers may experience an interior trim panel either loose or fitting poorly due to a
deformed or missing panel attachment clips. When a trim garnish (A, B, C or D pillar
garnish, door trim panel, etc.) is removed and reinstalled using the old clips, there is a
possibility that the garnish may exhibit a loose condition. To prevent this condition from
occurring, please use the following procedures.
Inspection/
Replacement
Procedure
All Models – All trim panel attachment clips must be inspected prior to reassembly and
replaced if any damage or wear is detected. If no damage is visible, the clip may be
reused. Always check to make sure that the garnish is properly attached after
reinstallation of all interior trim panels.
2002 – 2004 model year Camry and 2004 model year Solara – When removing the
A–pillar garnish panels, replace the white plastic attachment clips (P/N 90467–A0025).
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S All models.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
BODY
BO017-03
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
DOOR GLASS DISPLACEMENT
Models:
’98 – ’99 TMMK Camry
November 26, 1999
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
On some 1998 and 1999 Camry vehicles, the door glass may be displaced from the front
door glass run if the door is closed forcefully with the window partially down. A field fix
has been developed to remedy this condition.
S 1998 – 1999 TMMK Camrys vehicles produced prior to VINs listed below.
Production
Change
Information
MODEL
STARTING VIN
1999 TMMK produced Camry
4T1BG**K*XU602813
4T1BF**K*XU088877
4T1BG**K*XU917744
4T1BF**K*XU933406
NOTE:
Refer to 1998 Camry Repair Manual (Vol. 2) BO–Section for Door Panel Removal and
Window Regulator Servicing information.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
BD9008
R&R Door Trim / Modify Hole (both sides)
0.5
67402–AA011
53
57
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
BODY
BO017–99
Title:
DOOR GLASS DISPLACEMENT – BO017–99
Repair
Procedure
November 26, 1999
1. Lower the door glass, disconnect the power window switch, remove the front door
trim panel, speaker, and loosen the door mirror mounts to gain access to the door
glass and lower frames. Remove the front lower frame (2 screws).
2. Locate the lower window frame mounting hole on the door (see illlustration). Place a
towel or shop rag in the speaker hole to catch metal chips. Using a round file or die
grinder, enlarge the hole 2 mm toward the speaker (rear of the vehicle). Remove the
towel or shop rag and any metal chips in the door. Apply touch–up paint or rust
preventative to the hole.
2 mm →
←
3. Install a rubber stopper to the lower window frame according to directions in TSB
BO012–99.
4. Install the lower window frame. Assure the frame is tight against the glass and the
run is fully inserted in the lower window frame channel.
5. Temporarily connect the power window switch and operate the window. Check to
assure the door glass fully opens and closes easily.
6. Reinstall the door panel and components, check lock/unlock function and door
opening handle function.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
DOOR MIRROR WIND NOISE
Models:
’97 – ’99 Camry
December 3, 1999
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Wind/road noise heard around the door mirrors of some Japan produced Camry vehicles
may be caused by an improperly positioned mirror wire harness grommet and/or harness
connector.
S 1997 through 1999 Camry vehicles. (Japan produced only)
Production
Change
Information
Warranty
Information
PLANT
STARTING VIN
TMC
JT2BG22K * X0367325
JT2BG28K * X0367352
JT2BF22K * X0227381
JT2BF28K * X0227306
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
BD9006
Adjust the Wire Harness Grommet
and/or Connector (both sides)
0.4
87910–33150
59
57
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Repair
Procedure
1. Carefully pry off the door speaker
cover and remove the nut using a 10
mm socket that secures the speaker
to the door.
2. Look through the door mirror harness
access hole and check the position of
the wire harness grommet and wire
harness connector – the harness
connector should be inside the
grommet and the grommet should be
fully seated in the mirror housing.
Connector
and Grommet
Mirror Housing
Connector
Grommet
CORRECT POSITION
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
BODY
BO019–99
Title:
DOOR MIRROR WIND NOISE – BO019–99
INCORRECT POSITION A
December 3, 1999
INCORRECT POSITION B
Mirror Housing
Mirror Housing
Grommet
Connector
Repair
Procedure
INCORRECT POSITION C
Mirror Housing
Grommet
Grommet
Connector
Connector
3. To reposition the grommet and/or
harness connector onto the mirror
housing:
S Remove the mirror housing (3
nuts) from the door and carefully
unclip the mirror from the housing.
This will allow easier access and
reinstallation of the grommet
and/or harness connector.
S Reposition the grommet so it is
fully seated to the mirror housing.
Assure the harness connector is
inside the grommet.
Rear View Mirror
Outside Door
Mirror
Mirror Housing
Connector
Grommet
CORRECT POSITION
NOTE:
Refer to the 1998 Camry Repair Manual
pages BO–23 through BO–26.
4. Reinstall the door mirror and speaker
assembly:
S Secure the mirror to the housing.
Outside Rear
View Mirror
Cover
S Properly align and reinstall the
mirror assembly to the door.
tighten the three nuts. Torque:
5.5 NSm (56 KgfScm, 49 inSlb)
S Reinstall the door speaker (one
nut) and speaker cover onto the
door.
S Assure the power mirror
adjustment and the door speaker
functions properly.
Page 2 of 2
Door Trim
5.5 (55, 49, ftSlbf)
NSm (kgfScm, ftSlbf) : Specified Torque
Technical Service
BULLETIN
1999 TOYOTA SEAT BELT EXTENDERS
Models:
All ’95 through ’99 model years
July 3, 1998
Introduction
Toyota customers who find it necessary to
increase the length of their seat belts may
obtain Seat Belt Extenders at no cost
through their local Toyota dealer.
Seat Belt
S The extender is available in 6 inch, 9 inch,
12 inch, 15 inch and 18 inch lengths.
S The extender is available only in black.
Extender
S Owners are informed of the seat belt
extender availability through the Toyota
Owner’s Manual included in each vehicle.
The customer (individual requiring the extender) must visit a Toyota dealership to have
the required measurements made and to complete the seat belt extender worksheet.
The worksheet will allow the proper fitting and selection of a seat belt extender for the
customer. The dealership personnel should then determine the applicable part number
and place a Critical Order through the TDN Parts Network.
The dealership service department should complete the affixed Seat Belt Extender Label
and review the “owner instruction sheet” with the customer. The dealership should give a
copy of the completed worksheet to the customer and keep the original in the customer’s
file.
To assure utmost owner satisfaction, it is recommended that a dealership designate one
person to coordinate all activities related to the seat belt extender issue.
From past sales history, it is recommended that dealerships do not stock Seat belt
extenders due to low demand and the need for customer fitting.
This bulletin contains the following information:
Procedure and Flow Chart...................... Page
Application Chart and Notes.................. Page
Part Number Information........................ Page
Owner Instructions.................................. Page
Seat Belt Extender Worksheet............... Page
Affected
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
2
3
5
6
7
S All Toyota models, 1995 through 1999 model years.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 7
BODY
BO020–98
Title:
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS: ’95 – ’99 – BO020–98
Procedure
July 3, 1998
1. Owner requests a seat belt extender from dealer.
2. Dealer verifies the need for a seat belt extender and obtains a current copy of this
TSB and copies the worksheet.
3. Dealer measures the customer and completes the worksheet. Dealer determines the
correct part number and places a Critical Order for the part through the TDN Parts
Network.
4. Dealer receives seat belt extender and calls the customer in to check fit of the part.
5. If the seat belt extender fit is good, dealership personnel completes the customer
information label on the part, explains usage of the part, and gives the customer a
copy of the completed worksheet.
6. Dealer places a copy of the completed worksheet in the customer’s records.
PARTS
SUPPLY
DEALER
MEASURE
CUSTOMER
&
COMPLETE
WORKSHEET
PLACE
CRITICAL
ORDER
THROUGH
TDN
SHIP SEAT
BELT
EXTENDER
TO
DEALER
RECEIVE
COPY OF
WORKSHEET
& USE
EXTENDER
COMPLETE
LABEL AND
ADVISE
OWNER
TEST FIT
CUSTOMER
WITH PART
FILE
WORKSHEET
IN
CUSTOMER
RECORDS
EXTENDER FLOW CHART
Sample Seat
Belt Extender
Label
CAUTION
Driver
Page 2 of 7
OWNER
DEALER
Passenger
Front
Rear
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS: ’95 – ’99 – BO020–98
Front Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
July 3, 1998
FRONT SEAT – EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
’99
’98
R 5
R–5
R 5
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
N–6
N–6
N–6
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
R–5
R–3
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–2
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
R–3
N–6
N–6
N–6
N–6
R–3
RAV4
RH EXCEPT CONVERTIBLE
LH EXCEPT CONVERTIBLE
PASEO
CONVERTIBLE RH & LH
SDN & WGN..JPP W/TR
COROLLA
SDN & WGN..JPP W/QSS *3
MR2
CELICA
JPP
CAMRY
TOKAI RIKA
QSS
PREVIA
SIENNA
*4
JPP..TOKAI RIKA
T100
4RUNNER
JPP..QSS
NAP
XTRACAB
R–3*1
R–3
*3
*4
*4
R–5
R–3
SUPRA
REGULAR
CAB
’95
N/A
R 5
R–5
*2
NAP
COMPACT
TRUCK
(PICKUP) *4
R–5
*2
NAP (NUMMI, TMMC)
TACOMA
’96
K–5
TERCEL
AVALON
’97
Q–4
Q–4
Q–2
Q–2
Q–2
N/A
R–3
R–3
R–3
R–3
Q–2
Q–2
Q–2
Q–2
Q–2
N/A
N/A
R–5
R–3
R–3
Q–4
Q–4
N/A
N/A
N/A
S–1
S–1
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
*2
R–1
*3
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
(ALL)
Q–1
R–1
(ALL)
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
4 DOOR
K–5
K–5
K–5
K–1
K–1
K–5
R–3
R–3
R–3
R–3
LAND CRUISER
*1 If dimension “L” (length when in use) is under 24
inches the extender must not be used due to its
design and construction (illustration).
L
Extender
Lap Belt
Page 3 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS: ’95 – ’99 – BO020–98
Rear Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
July 3, 1998
REAR SEAT – EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
’99
’98
’97
’96
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
N–3
N–3*5
N–1
N–6
N–6*5
N–5
N/A
N/A
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–3
N/A
N/A
N/A
R–5
R–3
NAP (TMMC)
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–2
NAP (NUMMI)
T–1
T–1
A–2
A–2
A–2
LIFTBACK & COUPE
N–6
N–6
N–6
N–6
N–3
RH ..CONVERTIBLE
N–1
N–1
N–1
N–1
N–1
N–5
N–5
N–5
N–5
N–5
N/A
N/A
N/A
R–3
R–3
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–2
Q–2
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Q–2
Q–2
Q–2
Q–2
Q–2
SUPRA
N/A
R–3
R–3
PREVIA
N/A
N/A
R–5
R–3
R–3
SIENNA
Q–4
Q–4
N/A
N/A
N/A
XTRACAB
A–2
A–2
K–3
K–3
K–3
XTRACAB
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
R–1
XTRACAB
N/A
K–4
K–4
K–4
K–4
4RUNNER
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–5
R–1
LAND CRUISER
K–5
K–5
K–4
K–4
K–4
TOKAI RIKA
RAV4
QSS
*3
TOKAI RIKA
TERCEL
QSS
*2
*2
*3
RH.. CONVERTIBLE
LH.. CONVERTIBLE
PASEO
RH & LH ..COUPE
SDN & WGN..JPP W/TR
SDN ..JPP
COROLLA
CELICA
*2
W/QSS *3
LH ..CONVERTIBLE
JPP
QSS
NAP
COUPE & WAGON
N/A
SOLARA
Q–4
*4
AVALON
*4
TACOMA
*4
T100 *4
*2 This seat belt was supplied by TOKAI RIKA.
Make sure that the identification mark on the back
side of the seat belt buckle is the same as shown.
*3 This seat belt was supplied by QSS. Make sure
that the identification mark on the back side of the
seat belt buckle is the same as shown.
Page 4 of 7
N/A
*3
SDN
CAMRY
PICKUP
TOKAI RIKA
*2
’95
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS: ’95 – ’99 – BO020–98
Rear Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
(Continued)
July 3, 1998
*4 Extenders must not be used for center front seat belt positions for Avalon, Tacoma, Compact Pickup and
T100 models with bench seats or for the center rear seat belt positions, except for the 1997 – 1999
Camry.
*5 For 1998 model year through November 1997 production of Paseo convertibles, use N–1 for RH and N–5
for LH. For 1998 Paseo convertible models from December 1997 production, use N–3 and N–6.
Parts
Information
PART NUMBER PREFIX: 73399–
SERIES
LENGTH
6 INCH
9 INCH
12 INCH
15 INCH
18 INCH
R–1
–12010
–12020
–12030
–12040
–12050
R–2
–12160
–12170
–12180
–12190
–12200
R–3
–50010
–50020
–50030
–50040
–50050
R–4
–16010
–16020
–16030
–16040
–16050
R–5
–16060
–16070
–16080
–16090
–16100
N–1
–12060
–12070
–12080
–12090
–12100
N–3
–20011
–20021
–20031
–20041
–20051
N–4
–20060
–20070
–20080
–20090
–20100
N–5
–20110
–20120
–20130
–20140
–20150
N–6
–20160
–20170
–20180
–20190
–20200
K–1
–12110
–12120
–12130
–12140
–12150
K–2
–22010
–22020
–22030
–22040
–22050
K–3
–22060
–22070
–22080
–22090
–22100
K–4
–33010
–33020
–33030
–33040
–33050
K–5
–35010
–35020
–35030
–35040
–35050
A–1
–02010
–02020
–02030
–02040
–02050
A–2
–01060*6
–01070
–01080
–01090
–01100
Q–1
–02060
–02070
–02080
–02090
–02100
Q–2
–06010
–06020
–06030
–06040
–06050
Q–3
–0W010
–0W020
–0W030
–0W040
–0W050
Q–4
–0W010
–0W020
–0W030
–0W040
–0W050
S–1
–04010
–04020
–04030
–04040
–04050
T–1
–01110
–01120
–01130
–01140
–01150
*6 Length: 7 1/4”
Page 5 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS: ’95 – ’99 – BO020–98
Owner
Instructions
July 3, 1998
Failure to follow the recommendations indicated below could result in less effectiveness
of the seat belt restraint system in case of vehicle collision, causing personal injury.
The seat belt extender must not be used:
A. By anyone other than for whom it was provided (name recorded on seat belt
extender).
B. In any vehicle and/or seat position other than the one for which it was provided.
C. When the seat belt extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic
locking retractor), make sure the retractor is locked when in use.
If your seat belt cannot be fastened securely because it is not long enough, a
personalized seat belt extender is available from your Toyota dealer free of charge.
Please contact your local Toyota dealer so that the dealer can order the proper required
length for the extender. Bring the heaviest coat you expect to wear for proper
measurement and selection of length. Additional ordering information is available at your
Toyota dealer.
CAUTION:
When using the seat belt extender, observe the following. Failure to follow these
instructions could result in less effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in case
of vehicle accident, increasing the chance of personal injury.
S Never use the seat belt extender if you can COMFORTABLY fasten the seat belt
without it.
S Remember that the extender provided for you may not be safe when used on a
different vehicle, or for another person or at a different seating position than the
one originally intended for.
To connect the extender to the seat
belt, insert the tab into the seat belt
buckle so that the “PRESS” signs on
the buckle–release buttons of the
extender and the seat belt are both
facing outward as shown.
Seat Belt Release
You will hear a click when the tab locks
into the buckle.
When releasing the seat belt, press on
the buckle–release button on the
extender, not on the seat belt. This helps
prevent damage to the vehicle interior
and extender itself.
Seat Belt Extender
When not in use, remove the extender and store in the vehicle for future use.
Page 6 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS: ’95 – ’99 – BO020–98
July 3, 1998
SEAT BELT EXTENDER WORKSHEET
PLEASE COPY THIS ORIGINAL WORKSHEET FOR EACH EXTENDER NEEDED
CAUTION:
When using the seat belt extender, observe the following. Failure to follow these instructions could result in
less effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in case of vehicle accident, increasing the chance of
personal injury.
S To minimize the chance and/or severity of injury in an accident, the seat belt
extender must only be used:
1 By the person for whom it was provided
2 In the seat position for which it was provided
S The seat belt extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
S When the seat belt extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic
locking retractor), make sure the retractor is locked when extender belt is in use.
DEALER
DEALER CODE
SEAT BELT EXTENDER APPLICATION
DEALER NAME
APPLICANT
APPLICANT NAME
ADDRESS
ADDRESS
CITY & STATE
EMPLOYEE NAME
MODEL YEAR
ZIP
CITY & STATE
BODY TYPE
SEATING POSITION
ZIP
PHONE
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
DIRECTIONS FOR DETERMINING PROPER EXTENDER LENGTH
1.
2.
S
S
S
3.
4.
5.
6.
Place the seat in the position the applicant normally uses
With applicant in the seat, wearing thickest coat expected to be worn, pull belt all the way out and try to buckle
belt
If the belt latches into buckle and feels comfortable against upper chest area, an extender is not needed.
If belt does not buckle continue with step 3
If buckle latches but belt has no slack remaining, continue with step 3
Measure distance between applicant’s navel and seat belt buckle (dimension A) and enter on worksheet
With belt all the way out, measure distance between latch tip and buckle tip (dimension B) and enter on
worksheet
NOTE: If belt latches but there is no slack enter zero as dimension B
Subtract dimension B from dimension A and record number in check number box on worksheet
Seat belt extender length is dimension B rounded up to next extender length (without exceeding check number)
NOTE: If extender length exceeds check number, an extender can not be provided to the
customer
Dimension A:
NAVEL TO BUCKLE
Dimension B:
LATCH TO BUCKLE
A
Navel
Buckle
B
Latch
Buckle
SEAT BELT EXTENDER CALCULATION
DIMENSION A:
DIMENSION B:
CHECK NUMBER:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER AUTHORIZATION
S The same seat belt extender can be used for right and left seating applications. Each seat belt extender will have
a label identifying the owner, VIN and seating position. Seat belt extenders are available only in black.
S Applicant’s Signature: _________________________________________
Date: ______________________
(Actual user of seat belt extender)
Page 7 of 7
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SEAT BELT EXTENDER
Models:
’99 – ’01 Model Year
August 11, 2000
Introduction
Toyota customers who find it necessary to
increase the length of their seat belts may
obtain Seat Belt Extenders at no cost
through their local Toyota dealer.
Seat Belt
S The extender is available in 6 inch, 9 inch,
12 inch, 15 inch and 18 inch lengths.
S The extender is available only in black.
Extender
S Owners are informed of the seat belt
extender availability through the Toyota
Owner’s Manual included in each vehicle.
The customer (individual requiring the extender) must visit a Toyota dealership to have
the required measurements made and to complete the seat belt extender worksheet.
The worksheet will allow the proper fitting and selection of a seat belt extender for the
customer. The dealership personnel should then determine the applicable part number
and place a Critical Order through the TDN Parts Network.
The dealership service department should complete the affixed Seat Belt Extender Label
and review the “owner instruction sheet” with the customer. The dealership should give a
copy of the completed worksheet to the customer and keep the original in the customer’s
file.
To assure utmost owner satisfaction, it is recommended that a dealership designate one
person to coordinate all activities related to the seat belt extender issue.
From past sales history, it is recommended that dealerships do not stock Seat belt
extenders due to low demand and the need for customer fitting.
This bulletin contains the following information:
Procedure and Sample Label.................Page 2
Application Charts .................................Page 3–4
Part Number Information........................Page 5
Owner Instructions..................................Page 6
Seat Belt Extender Worksheet............... Page 7
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 1999 through 2001 model year Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 7
BODY
BO020–00
Title:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99 – ’01 MODEL YEAR – BO020–00
Procedure
August 11, 2000
1. Owner requests a seat belt extender from dealer.
2. Dealer verifies the need for a seat belt extender and obtains a current copy of this
TSB and copies the worksheet.
3. Dealer measures the customer and completes the worksheet. Dealer determines the
correct part number and places a Critical Order for the part through the TDN Parts
Network.
4. Dealer receives seat belt extender and calls the customer in to check fit of the part.
5. If the seat belt extender fit is good, dealership personnel completes the customer
information label on the part, explains usage of the part, and gives the customer a
copy of the completed worksheet.
6. Dealer places a copy of the completed worksheet in the customer’s records.
PARTS
SUPPLY
DEALER
MEASURE
CUSTOMER
&
COMPLETE
WORKSHEET
PLACE
CRITICAL
ORDER
THROUGH
TDN
SHIP SEAT
BELT
EXTENDER
TO
DEALER
DEALER
TEST FIT
CUSTOMER
WITH PART
COMPLETE
LABEL AND
ADVISE
OWNER
FILE
WORKSHEET
IN
CUSTOMER
RECORDS
Sample Seat
Belt Extender
Customer
Information
Label
Page 2 of 7
CAUTION
OWNER
RECEIVE
COPY OF
WORKSHEET
& USE
EXTENDER
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99 – ’01 MODEL YEAR – BO020–00
Front Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
August 11, 2000
FRONT SEAT – EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
TYPE
’01
’00
’99
RAV4
—
R–5
R–5
R–5
ECHO
—
K–5
5–5
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
COROLLA
TMMC PRODUCTION
NUMMI PRODUCTION
PRIUS
—
N–7
—
—
MR2 SPYDER
—
N–6
N–6
—
LIFTBACK & COUPE
N–6
N–6
CONVERTIBLE
—
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
—
T–1
T–1
Q–2
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
—
S–2
S–1
S–1
4RUNNER
—
K–5
K–5
K–5
LAND CRUISER
—
K–5
K–5
K–5
SEQUIOA
—
Q–4
—
—
—
Q–4
Q–4
—
CELICA
TMC PRODUCTION
CAMRY
TMMK PRODUCTION
CAMRY
SOLARA
AVALON
*1
SIENNA
TACOMA
TUNDRA
*1
*1
COUPE
COVERTIBLE
N–6
Q–4
Q–4
—
*1 The extender must not be used for the center seat belt of Avalon, Tacoma and Tundra which have bench
seats.
Page 3 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99 – ’01 MODEL YEAR – BO020–00
Rear Seat Belt
Extender
Applications
REAR SEAT – EXTENDER APPLICATION
MODEL
RAV4
ECHO
COROLLA
PRIUS
CELICA
TYPE
’01
R–5
’00
R–5*1
’99
R–5*1
W/TOKAI RIKA
W/QSS
—
Q–4*2
Q–4*2
—
R–5
R–5
—
TMMC PRODUCTION
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
NUMMI PRODUCTION
T–1
T–1
T–1
—
N–7
—
—
LIFTBACK & COUPE
N–6
N–6
N–6
—
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
CONVERTIBLE (RH)
CONVERTIBLE (LH)
CAMRY
TMC PRODUCTION
TMMK PRODUCTION
COUPE
N–1
N–5
Q–4
Q–4
CAMRY
SOLARA
CONVERTIBLE
AVALON
—
T–1
T–1
Q–2
SIENNA
—
Q–4
Q–4
Q–4
TACOMA
XTRACAB
A–2
A–2
A–2
4RUNNER
—
R–5
R–5
R–5
LAND CRUISER
—
K–5
K–5
K–5
SEQUOIA
REAR SEAT #1
T–1
SEQUOIA
REAR SEAT #2
Q–4
—
—
TUNDRA
ACCESS CAB
Q–4
Q–4
—
*1 This seat belt was supplied by TOKAI RIKA.
Make sure that the I/D mark on the back side of
the seat belt buckle is the same as shown.
*2 This seat belt was supplied by QSS. Make sure
that the I/D mark on the back side of the seat belt
buckle is the same as shown.
NOTE:
The seat belt extender must not be
used for the center rear seat belt.
Page 4 of 7
August 11, 2000
—
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99 – ’01 MODEL YEAR – BO020–00
Parts
Information
August 11, 2000
PART NUMBER PREFIX: 73399–
SERIES
LENGTH
6 INCH
9 INCH
12 INCH
15 INCH
18 INCH
R–5
–16060
–16070
–16080
–16090
–16100
N–1
–12060
–12070
–12080
–12090
–12100
N–5
–20110
–20120
–20130
–20140
–20150
N–6
–20160
–20170
–20180
–20190
–20200
N–7
–47010
–47020
–47030
–47040
–47050
K–5
–35010
–35020
–35030
–35040
–35050
A–2
–01060*1
–01070
–01080
–01090
–01100
Q–2
–06010
–06020
–06030
–06040
–06050
Q–4
–0W010
–0W020
–0W030
–0W040
–0W050
S–1
–04010
–04020
–04030
–04040
–04050
T–1
–01110
–01120
–01130
–01140
–01150
*1 Length: 7 1/4”
Page 5 of 7
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99 – ’01 MODEL YEAR – BO020–00
Owner
Instructions
August 11, 2000
Failure to follow the recommendations indicated below could result in less effectiveness
of the seat belt restraint system in case of vehicle collision, causing personal injury.
The Seat Belt Extender must not be used:
a. By anyone other than for whom it was provided (name recorded on seat belt
extender).
b. In any vehicle and/or seat position other than the one for which it was
provided.
c. When the Seat Belt Extender is provided for rear seat positions (with
automatic locking retractor), make sure the retractor is locked when in use.
If your seat belt cannot be fastened securely because it is not long enough, a
personalized seat belt extender is available from your Toyota dealer free of charge.
Please contact your local Toyota dealer so that the dealer can order the proper required
length for the extender. Bring the heaviest coat you expect to wear for proper
measurement and selection of length. Additional ordering information is available at your
Toyota dealer.
CAUTION:
When using the seat belt extender, observe the following. Failure to follow these
instructions could result in less effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in case
of vehicle accident, increasing the chance of personal injury.
S Never use the Seat Belt Extender if you can comfortably fasten the seat belt
without it.
S The Seat Belt Extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
S Remember that the extender provided for you may not be safe when used on a
different vehicle, or for another person or at a different seating position than the
one originally intended for.
To connect the extender to the seat
belt, insert the tab into the seat belt
buckle so that the “PRESS” signs on
the buckle–release buttons of the
extender and the seat belt are both
facing outward as shown.
Seat Belt Release
You will hear a click when the tab locks
into the buckle.
When releasing the seat belt, press on
the buckle–release button on the
extender, not on the seat belt. This helps
prevent damage to the vehicle interior
and extender itself.
When not in use, remove the extender and
store in the vehicle for future use.
Page 6 of 7
Seat Belt Extender
SEAT BELT EXTENDER: ’99 – ’01 MODEL YEAR – BO020–00
August 11, 2000
SEAT BELT EXTENDER WORKSHEET
PLEASE COPY THIS ORIGINAL WORKSHEET FOR EACH EXTENDER NEEDED
CAUTION:
S
S
S
To minimize the chance and/or severity of injury in an accident, the seat belt
extender must only be used:
1 By the person for whom it was provided
2 In the seat position for which it was provided
The seat belt extender must never be used with any child safety seats.
When the seat belt extender is provided for rear seat positions (with automatic
locking retractor), make sure the retractor is locked when extender belt is in use.
DEALER
DEALER CODE
SEAT BELT EXTENDER APPLICATION
DEALER NAME
APPLICANT
APPLICANT NAME
ADDRESS
ADDRESS
CITY & STATE
EMPLOYEE NAME
MODEL YEAR
ZIP
CITY & STATE
BODY TYPE
SEATING POSITION
ZIP
PHONE
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
DIRECTIONS FOR DETERMINING PROPER EXTENDER LENGTH
1.
2.
S
S
S
3.
4.
5.
6.
Place the seat in the position the applicant normally uses
With applicant in the seat, wearing thickest coat expected to be worn, pull belt all the way out and try to buckle
belt
If the belt latches into buckle and feels comfortable against upper chest area, an extender is not needed.
If belt does not buckle continue with step 3
If buckle latches but belt has no slack remaining, continue with step 3
Measure distance between applicant’s navel and seat belt buckle (dimension A) and enter on worksheet
With belt all the way out, measure distance between latch tip and buckle tip (dimension B) and enter on
worksheet
NOTE: If belt latches but there is no slack enter zero as dimension B
Subtract dimension B from dimension A and record number in check number box on worksheet
Seat belt extender length is dimension B rounded up to next extender length (without exceeding check number)
NOTE: If extender length exceeds check number, an extender can not be provided to the
customer
Dimension A:
NAVEL TO BUCKLE
Dimension B:
LATCH TO BUCKLE
Latch
Navel
Buckle
Buckle
A
B
SEAT BELT EXTENDER CALCULATION
DIMENSION A:
DIMENSION B:
CHECK NUMBER:
SEAT BELT EXTENDER AUTHORIZATION
S The same seat belt extender can be used for right and left seating applications. Each seat belt extender will have
a label identifying the owner, VIN and seating position. Seat belt extenders are available only in black.
S Applicant’s Signature: _________________________________________
Date: ______________________
(Actual user of seat belt extender)
Page 7 of 7
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SLIDING ROOF DIAGNOSTIC TIPS
Models:
’97 – ’01 TMMK Camry
August 17, 2001
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
The 1997 – 2001 model year TMMK Camry sliding roof assembly components are now
available as service parts. Additional diagnostic and repair information has been
developed to supplement the Repair Manual and to provide service tips for the sliding
roof components.
1997 – 2001 model year Camry vehicles built in the US (TMMK).
MODEL/PLANT
STARTING VIN
Camry (TMMK)
All VINs Begin with “4”
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Parts
Information
REF
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QTY
1
63201–AA010–83
Glass Sub–Assy, Sliding Roof
1
2
63202–AA010
Rail Sub–Assy, Slide Roof
1
3
63209–AA010
Panel Sub–Assy, Roof Wind Deflector
1
4
63214–AA010
Channel, Roof Drip, RR
1
5
63217–AA010
Garnish, Sliding Roof Side, RH
1
6
63218–AA010
Garnish, Sliding Roof Side, LH
1
7
63221–AA010
Guide, Roof Channel, RH
1
8
63222–AA010
Guide, Roof Channel, LH
1
9
63223–AA010
Cable, Sliding Roof Drive, RH
1
10
63224–AA010
Cable, Sliding Roof Drive, LH
1
11
63225–AA010
Spring, Roof Wind Deflector, RH
1
12
63226–AA010
Spring, Roof Wind Deflector, LH
1
13
63227–AA010
Arm, Sliding Roof Lift, RH
1
14
63228–AA010
Arm, Sliding Roof Lift, LH
1
15
63241–AA010
Bracket, Sliding Roof Housing Fr. Mtg., RH
2
16
63245–AA010
Bracket, Sliding Roof Housing Fr. Mtg., LH
2
17
63251–AA010
Weatherstrip, Sliding Roof
1
18
63260–AA010
Gear Assy, Sliding Roof Drive (Not Illustrated)
1
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 7
BODY
BO020-01
Title:
SLIDING ROOF DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – BO020-01
Parts
Information
(Continued)
August 17, 2001
REF
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QTY
19
63287–AA010
Cap, Sliding Roof Housing Drain End, RH
1
20
63288–AA010
Cap, Sliding Roof Housing Drain End, LH
1
21
63306–AA010–A1/B1/G1
Trim Sub–Assy, Sliding Shade
1
22
90080–11209
Bolt, With Washer
8
23
90084–14004
Screw, Hex Lobular
2
24
90084–15005
Screw, With Washer
4
25
90084–16013
Screw, Hex Lobular Tapping (Long)
2
26
90084–16014
Screw, Hex Lobular Tapping (Short) (Not Illustrated)
2
27
90084–26003
Rivet
6
28
90084–53003
Fastener, Hook
3
29
90159–60545
Screw, With Washer Tapping (Ground Wire)
1
30
90179–06069
Nut
6
1
24
5
17
25
6
3
11
4
13
12
7
8
14
10
21
9
23
Page 2 of 7
SLIDING ROOF DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – BO020-01
August 17, 2001
Parts
Information
(Continued)
27
19
2
28
15
20
16
22
30
Repair
Procedure
CONDITION
Glass Won’t Tilt
Glass Won’t Close
POSSIBLE CAUSE
29
COMMON REPAIR
Guide pin mis–adjusted
Re–adjust guide pin
Mechanism unlatched
Re–adjust guide pin
Damaged drive gear
assembly
Replace drive gear assembly
Damaged cable assembly
Replace cable assembly
Other damaged part
Replace damaged part
Rubber bumper comes off
Replace lift arm assembly
Foreign material
Remove foreign material and re–adjust
guide pin
Guide pin mis–adjusted
Re–adjust guide pin
Mechanism unlatched
Re–adjust guide pin
Damaged drive gear
assembly
Replace drive gear assembly
Damaged cable assembly
Replace cable assembly
Other damaged part
Replace damaged part
Rubber bumper comes off
Replace lift arm assembly
Foreign material
Remove foreign material and re–adjust
guide pin
Page 3 of 7
SLIDING ROOF DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – BO020-01
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
CONDITION
Glass Won’t Open
p
Glass J
Gl
Jammed/
d/
Binding/Seized
Abnormal Noise
Sunshade Difficult
to Move
Page 4 of 7
POSSIBLE CAUSE
August 17, 2001
COMMON REPAIR
Guide pin mis–adjusted
Re–adjust guide pin
Mechanism unlatched
Re–adjust guide pin
Damaged drive gear
assembly
Replace drive gear assembly
Damaged cable assembly
Replace cable assembly
Other damaged part
Replace damaged part
Rubber bumper comes off
Replace lift arm assembly
Foreign material
Remove foreign material and re–adjust
guide pin
Guide pin mis–adjusted
Re–adjust guide pin
Mechanism unlatched
Re–adjust guide pin
Damaged drive gear
assembly
Replace drive gear assembly
Damaged cable assembly
Replace cable assembly
Other damaged part
Replace damaged part
Rubber bumper comes off
Replace lift arm assembly
Foreign material
Remove foreign material and re–adjust
guide pin
Guide pin mis–adjusted
Re–adjust guide pin
Damaged drive gear
assembly
Replace drive gear assembly
Damaged garnish
Replace garnish
Damaged roof drip
channel guide
Replace roof drip channel guide
Other damaged part
Replace damaged part
Opening trim molding
installed incorrectly
Adjust trim position. See Service Tip on
page 7 of this bulletin.
Bent sunshade
Replace sunshade
Damaged or bent center
reinforcement
Straighten or replace center reinforcement
Damaged or bent rear
reinforcement
Straighten or replace rear reinforcement
Damaged or bent roof drip
channel
Straighten or replace drip channel
SLIDING ROOF DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – BO020-01
Service Tips
August 17, 2001
H The recommended sliding roof removal and disassembly procedure is provided in the
2001 Camry Repair Manual, pages BO–62 through BO–65. Take time to read the
procedure before disassembling the sliding roof assembly.
H When the system is diagnosed and the failed part is identified, the failed part can be
removed by following the disassembly procedure in the 2001 Camry Repair Manual
pages BO–66 through BO–67. Adjustment information is available on pages BO–68
and BO–69.
H Electrical diagnosis information can be found:
2001 Camry Repair Manual, pages BE–89 through BE–92.
2001 Camry Electrical Wiring Diagram, pages 168 through 170.
The following service tips are not provided in the Repair Manuals:
Drain Tube Function
To clear clogs in the drain tubes,
insert a long speedometer cable.
A long speedometer cable can be
inserted into each drain, to
determine if the drain tubes are
exiting to the ground instead of
inside the vehicle.
Do NOT blast air down the tube
because this can cause the drain
tube to become disconnected
from the sliding roof.
Guide Pin Adjustment
Adjustments are noted in the
2001 Camry Repair Manual,
page BO–69.
In addition, when the guide pin
roller moves up and down, the Lift
Arm should be able to move
forward–backward a distance of
0.6 mm +/– 0.2 mm.
Move Forward
0.6 mm +/– 0.2 mm
Down
Page 5 of 7
SLIDING ROOF DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – BO020-01
Service Tips
(Continued)
Rear Drain Cap Installation
The Repair Manual recommends
applying Seal Packing P/N
08826–00090 for installation of
the drain cap. Since this product
is not available through the parts
department, the recommended
product is:
3M Windo–Weld Sealer – Black
(3M Part Number 08606)
Moon Roof Opening Trim Removal
The opening trim has three
integrated snaps.
First remove the front section in a
perpendicular motion, then
remove the other sections.
Glass Panel Removal
If the screws (4 screws, Torx
Screw Driver) cannot be reached,
move the sliding roof forward by
turning the motor drive shaft with
a hex wrench.
Assure the glass panel is adjusted
according to the specifications in
the 2001 Camry Repair Manual
page BO–62.
Page 6 of 7
August 17, 2001
SLIDING ROOF DIAGNOSTIC TIPS – BO020-01
Service Tips
(Continued)
August 17, 2001
Glass Panel Adjustment
1. Glass Panel Closed, Skewed in the
Opening
Lift Arm Assembly
Tilt the glass panel
From the outside of the vehicle,
loosen the guide pin.
Guide Pin
Move the guide pin rearward in
small increments, until glass
closes evenly and exhibits no
popping sound. Tighten the pin.
Slide Rail
Cycle the sliding roof to verify
proper adjustment.
2. Glass Panel Tilts Down but Does Not
Retract
Tilt the glass panel
From the outside of the vehicle,
loosen the guide pin.
Move the pin forward in small
increments, until the glass retracts
quietly. Tighten the pin.
Cycle the sliding roof to verify
proper adjustment.
Sunshade Difficult to Move
Confirm the opening trim molding
is attached to the headliner so it
does not contact the sunshade.
If the trim is pushed up, it will rub
against the sunshade and cause
the sunshade to drag.
Opening Trim Molding
Sunshade
WRONG
CORRECT
Headliner
Page 7 of 7
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SEAT COVER LOOSENESS
Models:
’99 Camry & Sienna
December 17, 1999
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
On some 1999 Camry front seats and Sienna captain seats, the seat bottom cover may
become loose at the front lower J–clip. To correct this condition a change has been
made to the way the seat cover is fastened to the seat bottom.
S 1999 Camry & Sienna vehicles produced within the following VIN ranges.
MODEL/PLANT
BETWEEN VIN
Camry (Plant 1)
BG * XU575466 – BF * XU578340 / BF * XU085983 – BF * XU086274
Camry (Plant 2)
BG * XU908651 – BG * XU910853 / BF * XU932462 – BF * XU932748
Sienna
XU167107 – XU168859
NOTE:
When working with sheet metal wear Kevlar Gloves to protect your hands.
Camry
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
COMBO
DESCRIPTION
TIME
A&B
Re–attach
Re
attach Lower Portion of
Front Seat Cover (RH & LH)
11
1.1
OP CODE
COMBO
DESCRIPTION
TIME
711041
A&B
Re attach Lower Portion of
Re–attach
Captain Seat Cover (RH & LH)
06
0.6
711041
OPN
T1
T2
62
14
T1
T2
62
14
71071–xxxxx–xx
71072–xxxxx–xx
Sienna
OPN
71071–xxxxx–xx
71074–xxxxx–xx
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
BODY
BO020–99
Title:
SEAT COVER LOOSENESS – BO020–99
Repair
Procedure
December 17, 1999
1. For easier repair remove the complete
seat assembly.
2. If necessary, remove the manual seat
adjuster handle.
J–Clip/Rail
Seat Cover
Locking Tabs
Seat Bottom
3. Bend the locking tabs down.
4. Completely disengage the J–clip from
the seat adjuster frame (front area
only).
5. Using a screwdriver, bend the frame
J–clip retention clips to the front.
(Approximately 1.5 mm)
Up
Seat Adjuster Frame
Front
NOTE:
Original Condition: Retention clips are
bent to the rear.
J–clip
NOTE:
With a screwdriver, bend all 5 retention
clips 1.5 mm forward.
1.5 mm
Page 2 of 3
SEAT COVER LOOSENESS – BO020–99
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
December 17, 1999
6. Reassemble the seat cushion.
7. Bend the locking tabs over the
cushion.
Locking Tabs
8. After reinstallation of the seat and
manual seat adjuster handle
(if removed), check the seat cushion
retention and seat operation
(sit on seat and push cushion down).
9. Tighten the seat mounting screws to
the torque specifications in the Repair
Manual.
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SUNROOF OPERATION
Models:
’97 – ’99 TMMK Camry
December 17, 1999
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Production
Change
Information
Parts
Information
Some 1997 – 1999 TMMK Camry vehicles may experience an interruption in sunroof
operation (not opening or closing). Changes have been made to the roof drip channel
guides to improve operation. The guides were modified to increase the clearance
between the sun shade and opening flange by 2 mm. A radius was added to eliminate
the sharp corners of the guides.
S 1997 – 1999 TMMK Camry vehicles built before the production change.
MODEL
Camry (TMMK)
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
STARTING VIN
Plant 1
4T1BG*XU543595/BF*XU083791
Plant 2
4T1BG*XU901534/BF*XU932010
CURRENT PART NUMBER
63222–AA010
63221–AA010
Warranty
Information
PLANT
PART NAME
Roof Drip Channel Guide – LH
Same
Roof Drip Channel Guide – RH
OPCODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
614141
R & R Drip Channel Guide, Both RH and LH
2.0
63222–AA010
T1
T2
53 83
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
BODY
BO021–99
Title:
SUNROOF OPERATION – BO021–99
Repair
Procedure
December 17, 1999
Remove the Roof Drip Channel Guides (left & right) and replace with the current parts.
RH Lift Arm and Cable Assembly
Roof Drip Channell
RH Roof Drip Channel Guide
LH Roof Drip Channel Guide
LH Lift Arm and Cable Assembly
Drive Rail Assembly
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
October 12, 2001
Introduction
SUNVISOR VANITY MIRROR
IMPROVEMENT
Models:
’97 – ’01 NAP Camry
Production changes have been implemented on the 1997 – 2001 model year NAP Camry
vanity mirror assembly to improve strength and durability of the mirror cover hinge.
Mirror Cover Hinge
Applicable
Vehicles
S 1997 – 2001 model year NAP Camry vehicles.
Production
Change
Information
Parts
Information
Repair
Procedure
Warranty
Information
MODEL
STARTING VIN
2001 Camry
4T1B#2#K#1U045764 (Line 1)
4T1B#2#K#1U798163 (Line 2)
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
74310–AA095–A0/B0/G0
74310–AA096–A0/B0/G0
Right Sunvisor Assembly
74320–AA055–A0/B0/G0
74320–AA056–A0/B0/G0
Left Sunvisor Assembly
Replace damaged sunvisor with a service part.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
752101
R & R RH and/or LH Sunvisor Assembly
0.2
74310–AA095–##
or
74320–AA055–##
T2
62 16
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
BODY
BO025-01
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
October 19, 2001
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR TAPE SET
Models:
All Applicable Avalon, Camry, Corolla,
Previa & Sienna
To assist customers in preventing particle buildup and preserve the appearance of the
shoulder belt anchor, the following procedure has been developed.
S 1996 – 1999 model year Avalon vehicles.
S 1996 – 2001 model year Camry vehicles.
S 1993 – 2001 model year Corolla vehicles.
S 1996 – 1997 model year Previa vehicles.
S 1998 – 2001 model year Sienna *1 vehicles.
*1
Parts
Information
Except rear seat belt.
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
73205–48011
Tape Set, Shoulder Belt Anchor
NOTE:
The above tape set contains the fluorocarbon resin tape (2 pieces) and Velcro tape (1 piece).
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
BD1011
Clean the Shoulder Belt Anchor
0.3
73210–#####–##*1
73220–#####–##*1
T2
61 99
*1 OPN should be part number of whichever belt assembly that the procedure is performed on.
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
BODY
BO026-01
Title:
SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR TAPE SET – BO026-01
Installation
Procedure
1. CLEAN SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR
NOTE:
S Do not install the tape when the
vehicle temperature is below the
freezing point.
S Do not re–use removed fluorocarbon
resin tape.
A. Pull out the seat belt about 300
mm and attach a clip as shown in
the illustration.
HINT:
Preventing the seat belt from retraction
with a clip will make the following
work easier.
B. Put the Velcro tape (in the parts
kit) through the hole of the
shoulder belt anchor,
brush–shaped side to the anchor.
C. Pull both ends of the Velcro tape
with your hand and shave off the
dirt on the shoulder belt anchor by
moving the Velcro tape several
times as shown in the illustration.
NOTE:
Remove the dirt completely. Otherwise,
the fluorocarbon resin tape may not
adhere properly.
Page 2 of 4
October 19, 2001
SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR TAPE SET – BO026-01
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
October 19, 2001
2. INSTALL FLUOROCARBON RESIN
TAPE
A. Place the fluorocarbon resin tape
onto the seat belt as shown in the
illustration.
NOTE:
Before installation of the fluorocarbon
resin tape, it is necessary to pre–release
the colored film about 5 mm for each
side. (Not fully released.)
B. By pulling up the seat belt, put the
fluorocarbon resin tape through
the hole of the shoulder belt
anchor. Match the shoulder belt
anchor to the center of the tape.
C. Remove the upper side colored
film from the fluorocarbon resin
tape, and securely affix the tape
to the outside of the shoulder belt
anchor.
D. Remove the lower side colored
film from the fluorocarbon resin
tape, and securely affix the tape
to the outside of the shoulder belt
anchor.
NOTE:
S Be sure to affix the fluorocarbon
tape securely along all edges.
S Pay attention not to make any
wrinkles or slack in the fluorocarbon
resin tape.
E. Remove the clip.
Page 3 of 4
SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR TAPE SET – BO026-01
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
F. By pulling the seat belt up and
down several times, as shown in
the illustration, securely affix the
fluorocarbon resin tape and
confirm the smoothness of the
belt movement.
NOTE:
Affix the fluorocarbon resin tape on
the shoulder belt anchor to the other
side following the same procedure.
NOTE:
If the seat belt requires cleaning to
remove dirt, only use a neutral
detergent or lukewarm water to clean.
Use the seat belt after it is completely
dried, to confirm proper operation.
Page 4 of 4
October 19, 2001
Technical Service
BULLETIN
November 3, 2000
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
LEAKS INTO TRUNK
Models:
’97 - ’01 Camry (U.S.), ’98 - ’01 Sienna,
’99 - ’01 Solara & ’01 Avalon
A field fix is available for incidents of moisture and odors permeating into the vehicle.
The Quarter Panel Air Duct flaps may have become loose or missing. Replacing the
Quarter Panel Air Duct will remedy the condition.
S
S
S
S
1997
1998
1999
2001
– 2001 model year Camry (U.S. produced)
– 2001 model year Sienna
– 2001 model year Solara
model year Avalon
Production
Change
Information
MODEL
STARTING VIN
2001 MY Sienna
4T1BG22K81U019710
4T1BG22KB1U768622
4T1BF28K11U116208
4T1BF22K51U958204
4T3ZF13C#1U335575
2001 MY Solara
2T1CF22P#1C435983
2001 MY Solara Convertible
2T1FF28P#1C435448
2001 MY Avalon
4T1BF28B11U123532
2001 MY Camry, 4 cylinder
2001 MY Camry, 6 cylinder
Parts
Information
Repair
Procedure
Warranty
Information
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
62940-AA010
62940-AA011
Quarter Panel Air Duct
Replace the Quarter Panel Air Duct.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
BD0036
R & R Quarter Panel Air Duct
1.0
62940-AA010
T1
T2
62 57
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
BODY
BO028-00
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
December 7, 2001
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Maintenance,
Cleaning
and Use
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADE
MAINTENANCE AND CLEANING
Models:
All Models
The following procedures are recommended to maintain windshield wiper blade
performance.
S All models.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Recommendations for Windshield Wiper Maintenance, Cleaning and Use:
1. Scheduled Maintenance
S Check wiper rubber blades every 4 – 6 months or 7,500 miles for wear, cracking
and contamination.
S Clean glass and rubber wiper blades if blades are not clearing glass adequately.
If this does not correct the problem, then replace the rubber elements.
2. Cleaning Procedure
S Wiper Rubber: Bugs, dirt, sap and road grime on blades will cause streaking.
Clean wiper rubber of road and environmental debris using cloth or paper towel
soaked with windshield washer fluid or mild detergent.
S DO NOT USE fuel, kerosene, or petroleum based products to clean rubber wiper
blades.
S Windshield: Bugs, road grime, sap and car wash wax treatments decrease wiper
performance.
S Rinse windshield with water and apply non–abrasive cleaner, such as Bon–Ami
(www.faultless.com), with a sponge.
NOTE:
Make sure to use plenty of water with all powder based cleaners so the glass is
not scratched.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
BODY
BO030-01
Title:
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADE MAINTENANCE AND CLEANING – BO030-01
Maintenance,
Cleaning
and Use
(Continued)
December 7, 2001
3. Contributors to Poor Performance/Decreased Rubber Blade Life (require rubber
replacement)
S Dusty areas cause the rubber edge to wear quickly.
S Sand and salt used for road conditioning during winter causes the edge to wear
quickly, so areas with significant snowfall require more frequent wiper
replacement.
S Heat and time cause the rubber to become excessively “permanent set,” so the
rubber does not turn over, resulting in streaking and/or unwiped areas on the
glass.
S Rubber is easily cut or torn while using ice scrapers on the glass.
S Rubber can be torn when pulling blades off a frozen windshield.
S Using wipers instead of an ice scraper to remove frost and ice from the windshield
during a car warm up can dull, nick, or tear the rubber.
S Banging wiper on the glass to remove ice & snow can cause the blade to bend
and rubber to come out of the blade providing the potential to scratch the glass.
S Ice forms in wiper blade pin joints, which causes streaking and unwiped areas. To
remove ice from pin joints, compress the blade and rubber with your hand to
loosen the frozen joints. To prevent this condition, use winter blades with a rubber
cover.
Page 2 of 2
BRAKES
BK91-001
MARCH 15, 1991
ALL MODELS
BRAKE DISC ANTI–RUST COVER REMOVAL
Page 1 of 2
During the removal of the Anti–Rust Covers, do not use screwdrivers or other sharp objects. The
use of such tools may result in the scratching of the outer rotor surface.
Step–by–step instructions for removing the Anti–Rust Covers are provided on the following page.
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES U.S.A., INC.
Printed on Recycled Paper.
BRAKE DISC ANTI–RUST COVER REMOVAL (CONT’D)
Page 2 of 2
RECOMMENDED REMOVAL PROCEDURE:
Turn the right front wheel to full right lock.
Unhook the Anti–Rust Cover from the disc brake dust cover, then pull the center of the Anti–Rust
Cover toward the wheel. This separates the Anti–Rust Cover from the disc brake dust cover (see
illustration below).
Pull the center of the Anti–Rust Cover by hand towards you to break the thin portion of cover.
Remove the Anti–Rust Cover along the arch of the wheel disc by shaking it up and down. If the
cover is torn while removing, check to see that no parts of the cover are left inside.
Turn the steering wheel to full left lock and perform the same steps on the left front wheel. If
applicable, also remove the Anti–Rust Covers on the rear brakes.
Indicate on the new car inspection sheet that the Anti–Rust Covers have been removed.
Technical Service
BULLETIN
FRONT BRAKE NOISE
Models:
’97–’99 V–6 Camry and ’98–’99 Avalon
April 23, 1999
Introduction
New Front Brake Pad Kits are available to reduce front brake groan or grinding noise on
1997–1999 V6 Camry and 1998–1999 Avalon.
S 1997–1999 V6 Camrys built before VINs 4T1BF2 * K * XU078781 (NAP – Plant 1)
Affected
Vehicles
4T1BF2 * K * XU930650 (NAP – Plant 2)
JT2BF2 * K * X0179640 (TMC)
S 1998–1999 Avalons built before VIN 4T1BF18B * XU310454
Parts
Information
*
Repair
Procedure
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
04465–33121
Front Brake Pads
04945–33040
Shim Kit (If Needed*)
Visually inspect Shims for heat discoloration. If discolored, replace shims.
1. Surface the disc rotors with the “On–Car Brake Lathe” to within serviceable limits.
2. If the rotors are unserviceable or below minimum thickness, replace the rotors.
3. Check any new disc rotors for runout.
4. If the disc rotor runout is over 0.03 mm (0.00012 in), perform a phase matching
procedure.
5. Replace the front brake pads.
6. Road test.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
COMBO
DESCRIPTION
TIME
Grind Front Discs and Replace Pads, Shims
(if needed) for Squeak (both sides)
473025
A
Grind Front Discs and Replace Pads, Shims
(if needed) for Vibration (both sides)
Grind Front Discs and Replace Pads, Shims
(if needed) for Groan/Grinding (both sides)
OPN
T1
T2
36 99
2.1
04465–33121 21 99
91 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
BRAKES
BR001–99
Title:
BRAKES
BR94–002
FEBRUARY 7, 1994
ALL MODELS
BRAKE VIBRATION AND/OR PULSATION
Page 1 of 6
This TSB outlines the causes of brake vibration and pulsation, as well as the best corrective
measures to use.
CONTENTS
1)
2)
3)
4)
Symptoms of brake vibration and pulsation
Cause of vibration/pulsation problems
Advantages of using an on–car brake lathe
Rotor replacement and off–car brake lathe procedure
1) SYMPTOMS OF BRAKE VIBRATION AND PULSATION
Brake vibration problems generally involve one or both of two phenomena: body vibration and/
or pedal pulsation.
A. BRAKE VIBRATION
Applying brakes causes vibration to occur in the instrument panel, steering column, steering
wheel, and/or body of the vehicle (See Figure 1 below).
Figure 1
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES U.S.A., INC.
BRAKE VIBRATION AND/OR PULSATION
Page 2 of 6
B. PEDAL PULSATION
Applying brakes causes the brake pedal to pulsate. This brake pulsation sometimes
causes the steering wheel to oscillate when the brakes are applied (See Figure 2 below).
Figure 2
2)
CAUSE OF VIBRATION/PULSATION PROBLEMS
Brake rotor thickness variation causes brake vibration due to changes in the braking force as
thick/thin portions of the rotor pass the pads. Brake rotor thickness variation can be measured
with a micrometer as shown in Figure 3 below.
10 mm
Divide Into
8 Equal Parts & Measure
at each location
Thickness Variation = Maximum – Minimum
BR002–94
Figure 3
BRAKE VIBRATION AND/OR PULSATION
Page 3 of 6
There are two factors which cause excessive rotor thickness variation:
A. ROTOR RUNOUT
– Rotor runout can be caused by poor mating of flanges between the hub and rotor when
assembled as a unit. Manufacturing tolerance stack–up of the rotor and hub may also
cause excessive rotor assembly runout (See Figure 4 below).
– If there is rotor runout, a portion of the rotor comes into contact with the brake pad on
each rotor revolution. If left like this, the portion of the rotor that contacts the brake pad
becomes worn, creating thickness variation.
Thickness Variation = A – B
A
Runout
B
Figure 4
B. EXCESSIVE RUST OR CORROSION ON ROTOR SURFACE
– Driving in areas where salt is applied to road surfaces for winter conditions can cause
rust and corrosion when the vehicle is parked for an extended period of time. This occurs
on the area where the brake pads are not in contact with the rotor.
– When a vehicle is driven with rusted rotors, the area with corrosion wears at a
different rate than the non–corroded areas, resulting in excessive thickness variation.
BR002–94
BRAKE VIBRATION AND/OR PULSATION
Page 4 of 6
3) Advantages Of Using An On–Car Brake Lathe
Toyota Motor Corporation Engineers strongly recommend that an on–car brake lathe be used
for repairing brake vibration and pulsation. This method improves rotor and hub combined
runout, and is the preferred method when compared to rotor replacement and off–the–car rotor
machining.
A. Technical Advantage of Caliper Mounted Brake Lathe
–
–
Installing the brake lathe in the same position as the caliper results in minimal runout
relative to the caliper.
Eliminating this runout minimizes the pad grinding on the rotor and reduces rotor
thickness variation.
B. Practical Use Benefits
–
–
Resurfacing rotors on vehicles with rotor/hub assemblies can be performed easily.
Vehicles with corrosion between hub and rotor flanges can be machined without
removing rotor from hub.
4) Rotor Replacement And Off–Car Brake Lathe Procedures
If an on–car brake lathe is not available at your dealership, it may be necessary to use an off–car
lathe or replace rotors. In order to ensure proper brake vibration and pulsation repairs, pay close
attention to the following precautions:
A. Off–Car Brake Lathe Precautions
–
–
–
–
–
Perform routine maintenance of brake lathe components (clearance of arbor shaft to
adapters may need to be repaired).
Clean all adapters and shaft to maintain accuracy of equipment.
When installing rotor to machine, clean mud, rust, and/or foreign material from the
adapters and rotors.
After installing rotor on machine, check rotor runout using dial indicator. If runout is
excessive, determine the cause and correct it.
Follow lathe manufacturer repair procedures. Do not cut excessive amounts off rotor
during the first cut to save time.
Anytime a rotor is machined it must be measured for minimum rotor thickness. The
thickness for the rotor is never to be less than minimum thickness as specified in the
appropriate repair manual.
BR002–94
BRAKE VIBRATION AND/OR PULSATION
Page 5 of 6
B. Installation of Rotor
–
–
Check wheel bearing pre–load. If excessive movement is found, adjust bearing
pre–load.
Using a dial indicator, measure the rotor 10 mm from the outside edge
(See Figure 5 below).
Figure 5
BR002–94
BRAKE VIBRATION AND/OR PULSATION
Page 6 of 6
C. Phase Match Rotor To Hub
–
If rotor runout is at the maximum value or greater, (refer to appropriate repair manual)
index the rotor one lug and measure the runout again. Repeat this process, moving the
rotor one lug each time, until the position is found where the runout is at the minimum and
within the maximum value listed in the appropriate repair manual
(See Figure 6 below).
Figure 6
–
Tighten lug nuts to the specified torque following a star sequence when installing wheel
(See Figure 7 below).
Note: DO NOT USE AIR IMPACT WRENCH.
Four Holes
Five Holes
Figure 7
BR002–94
REAR BRAKE DRUM NOISE
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’99 Camry – NAP
July 16, 1999
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Rear Brake Drums are available to reduce rear brake drum howling/groaning noise on
NAP built Camrys.
S 1999 4 cylinder NAP built Camrys built before:
4T1BG2 * K * XU568428 (NAP – Plant 1)
4T1BG2 * K * XU900266 (NAP – Plant 2)
Parts
Information
Repair
Procedure
Warranty
Information
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
42431–33020
Rear Brake Drum
If the customer encounters a brake groan or howling noise, replace the rear brake drums.
OP CODE
COMBO
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
472151
A
R & R Rear Brake Drum (Both Sides)
1.1
42431–33020
91
99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
BRAKES
BR004–99
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
BRAKE PAD CLICKING NOISE
Models:
’90 – ’00 All Models
October 20, 2000
Introduction
A clicking type noise may be noticed when first applying the brakes after changing
vehicle travel direction (Drive/Forward to Reverse, Reverse to Drive/Forward). This is a
normal noise caused by the required brake pad–to–caliper clearances. When the
direction of travel is changed, the brake pads may “shift” towards the new direction of
travel. When the brake pad contacts the caliper, a clicking noise may be heard.
To minimize this clicking noise, a disc brake caliper grease has been made available for
use during brake service/maintenance operations. Under normal usage conditions this
grease should be effective for a period of 6 months to 1 year.
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
S 1990 – 2000 model year Toyota vehicles, all models.
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
N/A
08887–80609
Disc Brake Caliper Grease (50 g tube)
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
BRAKES
BR004–00
Title:
BRAKE PAD CLICKING NOISE – BR004–00
Application
Procedure
October 20, 2000
There are two types of brake calipers: floating and fixed. Check the type of brake caliper
installed on the vehicle by removing the wheel assembly.
1. Floating Type Brake Caliper
A. Lift up or remove the brake caliper
and suspend it securely.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose
from the brake caliper.
B. If equipped with anti–squeal
spring: Remove the anti–squeal
springs.
C. Remove the brake pads with
anti–squeal shims.
D. Remove the pad support plates
from the torque plate. Clean any
dust from the pad support plates,
torque plates and brake pads.
E. Apply a small amount of the
disc brake caliper grease
(1–2 mm thick) to both sides
of the pad support plates.
Torque
Plate
Pad Support
Plates
Pad Support Plates
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction
surfaces of the brake pads or the
disc rotor.
F. If the pad support plate is fixed to
the torque plate with adhesive tape,
perform the operation according to
the following flow chart.
Apply Disc Brake Caliper Grease
Check whether or not the pad support plate
and the torque plate are fixed firmly in place
with adhesive tape.
Fixed firmly in place
Without removing the pad
support plate, apply a small
amount of grease to the portion
where the pad touches the
surface of the support plate.
Page 2 of 4
There is adhesive tape, but
it is not fixed firmly in place
Adhesive tape is peeled off
Remove the pad support plate,
peel off the adhesive tape and
apply a small amount of grease to
both sides of the support plate.
Remove the pad support plate
and apply a small amount of
grease to both sides of the
support plate.
BRAKE PAD CLICKING NOISE – BR004–00
Application
Procedure
(Continued)
G. Apply a small amount of the
disc brake caliper grease
(1–2 mm thick) to the caliper
as indicated in the illustration.
H. Install the brake pads with the
anti–squeal shims.
I. If equipped with anti–squeal
spring: Install the anti–squeal
springs.
J. Press the piston in firmly and
install the brake caliper.
October 20, 2000
Apply Disc Brake
Caliper Grease
NOTE:
S Clean excess grease from brake
pad and caliper.
S Do NOT apply grease to the friction
surfaces of the brake pads or the
disc rotor.
K. Install the wheel assembly.
2. Fixed Type Brake Caliper
There are two types of brake pads:
S Type “A”: Has a projection on the
upper and lower side of the brake
pad. (See illustration.)
Type “A”
Brake Pad
Type “B”
Brake Pad
Flat Edge
Projection
S Type “B”: Has a flat upper and
lower edge on the brake pad
backing plate.
Type “A” Brake Pad
A. Remove the anti–squeal spring,
clip and pad guide pin.
B. Remove the brake pads with the
anti–squeal shims.
C. Clean any dust from the brake
pads.
Type “A” Brake Pad
Page 3 of 4
BRAKE PAD CLICKING NOISE – BR004–00
Application
Procedure
(Continued)
October 20, 2000
D. Apply a small amount of the
disc brake caliper grease
(1–2 mm thick) to the areas
indicated in the illustration.
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction
surfaces of the brake pads or the
disc rotor.
E. Install the brake pads with the
anti–squeal shims.
Apply Disc Brake
Caliper Grease
NOTE:
Clean excess grease from the brake
pads and caliper.
F. Install the pad guide pin, clip and
anti–squeal spring.
G. Install the wheel assembly.
Type “B” Brake Pad
A. Remove the clip, pins and
anti–rattle spring/pad retainer clip.
B. Remove the brake pads with the
anti–squeal shims.
C. Clean any dust from the brake
pads.
Type “B” Brake Pad
D. Apply a small amount of the
disc brake caliper grease
(1–2 mm thick) to the areas
indicated in the illustration.
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction
surfaces of the brake pads or the
disc rotor.
E. Install the brake pads with the
anti–squeal shims.
NOTE:
Clean excess grease from the brake
pads and caliper.
F. Install the pad guide pin, clip and
anti–squeal spring.
G. Install the wheel assembly.
Page 4 of 4
Apply Disc Brake
Caliper Grease
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SINGLE CYLINDER MISFIRES
Models:
’99 Avalon, Camry, Sienna & Solara (CA Spec.)
January 14, 2000
NOTE:
The information contained in this TSB updates EG013–99 dated December 17, 1999.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
Some 1999 California Emission Specification Avalon, Camry (1MZ–FE), Sienna & Solara
(1MZ–FE) vehicles may exhibit a rough idle, and or a M.I.L. “ON“ condition, in which a
single cylinder misfire code, or codes are present. Changes have been made in the fuel
injector production process to correct this condition.
S 1999 CA Emission Spec. TMMK produced Avalon, Camry (1MZ–FE), Sienna &
TMMC produced Solara (1MZ–FE) vehicles built between the VIN numbers listed
below.
MODEL
STARTING VIN
ENDING VIN
Avalon
4T1BF1#B*XU298504
4T1BF1#B*XU319557
Camry
4T1BF2#K*XU076403
4T1BF2#K*XU081214
Camry (cont.)
4T1BF2#K*XU930024
4T1BF2#K*XU931330
Sienna
4T3ZF1#C*XU090887
4T3ZF1#C*XU122589
Solara (U.S.)
2T1CF2#P*XC111083
2T1CF2#P*XC757508
Solara (Canada)
2T1CF2#P*XC744113
2T1CF2#P*XC162681
APPLICABLE PARTS
QUANTITY
PART NAME
23209–0A010
6
Fuel Injector
OP CODE
VWC
DESCRIPTION
TIME
895221
N
R & R Fuel Injector Assembly – All
1.8
OPN
T1
T2
23209–0A010 02 56
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Federal Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the
states of California, Massachusetts, and Vermont due to state emission warranty
legislation.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
NOTE:
Be sure to enter the DTC No. in the Condition/Cause/Remedy section, if a DTC Code
appeared.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ENGINE
EG001–00
Title:
SINGLE CYLINDER MISFIRE – EG001-00
Repair
Procedure
1. Remove all six fuel injectors for
verification of production information.
Affected injectors will be labeled with
a vendor part number of
“23250–0A010“ and have a
production date code number of “828“
or lower (see illustration for number
locations).
2. After determining that one or more of
the injectors are affected, replace all
six injectors with the above applicable
part number.
3. Clear the DTC, if present, and verify
that the vehicle now operates as
designed.
Page 2 of 2
January 14, 2000
Production
Date
Part Number
Technical Service
BULLETIN
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE P1133
Models:
’97 – ’99 Camry: 1MZ–FE CA Spec.
February 25, 2000
TSB Revision Notice:
The information updated in this TSB is red and underlined.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Under certain driving conditions, some 1MZ–FE equipped 1997 – 1999 Camry California
Emission specification vehicles can exhibit a M.I.L. “ON” DTC P1133. An improved
Air/Fuel Ratio Sensor has been developed to correct this condition.
S 1997 – 1999 Camry (1MZ–FE) with California Emission Specification.
Production
Change
Information
Parts
Information
Repair
Procedure
MODEL YEAR
1999 Camry
ENGINE
STARTING VIN
1MZ–FE
4T1BF2#K * XU088001
4T1BF2#K * XU933227
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
89467–41020
89467–41021
Sensor, Air/Fuel
S Should a M.I.L. “ON” condition with DTC P1133 be encountered, perform diagnostic
procedures as described in the Repair Manual.
S If the problem source cannot be identified after checking all affected areas according
to the Repair Manual, the cause may be an Air/Fuel Ratio Sensor malfunction. In this
case, replace the Air/Fuel Ratio Sensor with the current part number listed above.
S If the Exhaust Manifold threads are damaged by removal of the sensor, they can be
repaired by the proper use of a M18 x 1.5 tap.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
895131
R & R Air/Fuel Ratio Sensor
0.3
89467–41020
T1
T2
99 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the
states of California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
NOTE:
Please enter the DTC in the condition/Cause/Remedy section when applying for
warranty reimbursement.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
ENGINE
EG002–00
Title:
ENGINE
EG003-96
OCTOBER 11, 1996
ALL MODELS
UNDERCOATING ON OXYGEN SENSORS
Page 1 of 1
During vehicle processing by Dealers, care must be taken to avoid applying undercoating in the
area surrounding the Oxygen Sensors. Application of undercoating on or near the Oxygen Sensors
can cause insufficient air to flow around the sensor, and inaccurate information storage by the ECM.
If this condition occurs, the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may illuminate.
Sub Oxygen Sensor
Main Oxygen Sensor
Center Pipe to Muffler
Avoid undercoating this area
Front Pipe to Manifold
Technical Service
BULLETIN
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS
Models:
All ’96 – ’02
March 29, 2002
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
The information updated in this TSB is red and underlined.
Introduction
The On–Board Diagnostic (OBDII) system is designed to monitor the performance of
emission–related components and report any detected abnormalities in the form of
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs). Since the various components need to be monitored
during different driving conditions, the OBDII system is designed to run separate
monitoring programs called Readiness Monitors. Many state Inspection and
Maintenance (I/M) programs require that vehicles complete their Readiness Monitors
prior to beginning an emissions test.
The current status of the Readiness Monitors can be seen by using the Toyota Diagnostic
Tester with version 9.0 software (or newer), or a generic OBDII Scantool.
To view the Readiness Monitor status using the Toyota Diagnostic Tester, select “Monitor
Status” from the Enhanced OBDII Menu.
A status of “complete” indicates that the necessary conditions have been met to run the
performance tests for the related Readiness Monitor.
The Readiness Monitor will be reset to “incomplete” if:
ECU has lost power (battery or fuse).
DTCs have been cleared.
The conditions for running the Readiness Monitor have not been met.
In the event that any Readiness Monitor shows “incomplete,” follow the appropriate
Readiness Monitor Drive Pattern to change the readiness status to “complete.”
Refer to the Readiness Monitor Drive Pattern Application Table to determine which
drive pattern should be followed.
Contents
SECTION
PAGE(S)
Readiness Monitor Drive Pattern Application Tables
Readiness Monitor Drive Patterns
1
EGR Monitor (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
2
EGR Monitor (For 1FZ–FE Engine)
3
Catalyst Monitor (O2S Type)
4
Catalyst Monitor (AF Sensor Type)
5
EVAP Monitor (Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
6
EVAP Monitor (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
7
EVAP Monitor (Without Leak Detection)
8
EVAP Monitor (For Prius)
9
Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front and Rear O2S System)
10
Oxygen/AF Sensor Monitor (Front AF Sensor and Rear O2S System)
11
Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
3–9
10
11
12
13
14–15
16–17
18
19–20
21
22
23
All 1996 – 2002 model year Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 23
ENGINE
EG003-02
Title:
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Terms &
Definitions
Required
Tools &
Material
March 29, 2002
J1930 TERM
J1930 DEFINITION
TOYOTA/LEXUS DIAGNOSTIC TESTER PARAMETER
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake Air
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temp
TOOLS & MATERIAL
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit
01001271
1
12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
with version 9.0a Software (or later)
01002593-005
1
NOTE:
A generic OBDII Scantool can be used in place of the Toyota Diagnostic Tester.
CAUTION:
Strict observance of posted speed limits, traffic laws and road conditions are
required when performing these drive patterns.
NOTE:
These drive patterns represent the fastest method to satisfy all necessary
conditions which allow the specific Readiness Monitor to complete.
In the event that the drive pattern must be interrupted (possibly due to traffic
conditions or other factors) the drive pattern can be resumed and, in most cases,
the Readiness Monitor will still set to “complete.”
To ensure rapid completion of Readiness Monitors, avoid sudden changes in
vehicle load and speed (driving up and down hills and/or sudden acceleration).
Underhood
Emission
Control
Information
Label
SAMPLE EMISSION CONTROL INFORMATION LABEL
VEHICLE EMISSION CONTROL INFORMATION
TOYOTA MOTOR CORPORATION
TEST GROUP : 1TYXV02.2JJA
SFI, EGR, A/F S, WU–TWC, TWC, HO2S
EVAP. FAMILY : 1TYXR0135AK1
2.2 LITER
ENGINE TUNE–UP SPECIFICATIONS FOR ALL ALTITUDES
VALVE CLEARANCE
INTAKE
0.19–0.29 mm [0.007–0.011 in.]
(ENGINE AT COLD)
EXHAUST
0.28–0.38 mm [0.011–0.015 in.]
NO OTHER ADJUSTMENTS NEEDED.
2 2 V A G J J Y
7A650
2AZ–FE USA
EGR = Exhaust Gas Recirculation
A/F S = Air Fuel Sensor
O2S = Oxygen Sensor
Page 2 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive Pattern
Application
Tables
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NUMBER*
O2S/AF
MODEL
YEAR
EGR
1
2
3
4
SENSOR
EVAP
5
6
7
8
9
10
HTR
11
ENGINE
Tercel
5E–FE
X
X
X
X
X
Paseo
5E–FE
X
X
X
X
X
Corolla
7A–FE
X
X
X
X
X
7A–FE
X
X
X
X
X
5S–FE
X
X
X
X
X
MTM
X
X
X
X
X
ATM
X
X
X
X
X
MTM
X
X
X
X
X
ATM
X
X
X
X
X
1MZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
2JZ–GE
X
X
X
X
X
2JZ-GTE
X
X
X
X
RAV4
3S–FE
X
X
X
X
Previa
2TZ–FZE
X
X
X
X
X
2RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
3RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
5S FE
5S–FE
Camry
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
Avalon
Supra
CATEGORY
CATALYST
MODEL
Celica
1996
DRIVE
TRAIN
2WD
Tacoma
5VZ–FE
4WD
w/EGR**
w/oEGR**
3RZ–FE
4Runner
w/EGR**
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
w/oEGR**
3RZ–FE
T100
Land
Cruiser
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
2WD
or
4WD
w/EGR**
w/oEGR**
N/A
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
N/A
1FZ–FE
X
X
X
N/A
* Readiness Monitor Drive Patterns:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
EGR (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
EGR (For 1FZ–FE Engine)
Catalyst (O2S Type)
Catalyst (AF Sensor Type)
EVAP (Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
EVAP (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
7. EVAP (Without Leak Detection)
8. EVAP (For Prius)
9. Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front & Rear O2S System)
10. Oxygen/AF Sensor Monitor (Front AF Sensor &
Rear O2S System)
11. Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
** Refer to Underhood Emissions Label on page 2.
Page 3 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive Pattern
Application
Tables
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NUMBER*
O2S/AF
MODEL
YEAR
DRIVE
TRAIN
EGR
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
HTR
11
ENGINE
Tercel
5E–FE
X
X
X
X
X
Paseo
5E–FE
X
X
X
X
X
Corolla
7A–FE
X
X
X
X
X
7A–FE
X
X
X
X
X
5S–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Fed
X
X
X
X
CA
X
MTM
5S–FE
ATM
Camry
y
X
X
X
X
X
MTM
X
X
X
X
X
ATM
X
X
X
X
X
1MZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
2JZ–GE
X
X
X
X
X
2JZ-GTE
X
X
X
X
RAV4
3S–FE
X
X
X
X
Previa
2TZ–FZE
X
X
X
X
X
2RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
3RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
Avalon
Supra
1997
1
SENSOR
EVAP
MODEL
Celica
CATEGORY
CATALYST
Tacoma
5VZ–FE
4Runner
2WD
or
4WD
w/EGR**
4WD
w/oEGR**
3RZ–FE
X
5VZ–FE
N/A
3RZ–FE
T100
5VZ–FE
Land
Cruiser
N/A
2WD
w/EGR**
2WD
or
4WD
w/oEGR**
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
N/A
1FZ–FE
X
X
X
N/A
* Readiness Monitor Drive Patterns:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
EGR (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
EGR (For 1FZ–FE Engine)
Catalyst (O2S Type)
Catalyst (AF Sensor Type)
EVAP (Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
EVAP (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
** Refer to Underhood Emissions Label on page 2.
Page 4 of 23
7. EVAP (Without Leak Detection)
8. EVAP (For Prius)
9. Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front & Rear O2S System)
10. Oxygen/AF Sensor Monitor (Front AF Sensor &
Rear O2S System)
11. Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive Pattern
Application
Tables
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NUMBER*
O2S/AF
MODEL
YEAR
MODEL
ENGINE
Tercel
5E–FE
Paseo
5E–FE
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
Celica
5S–FE
DRIVE
TRAIN
1MZ–FE
1998
1MZ–FE
5
6
7
8
9
10
HTR
11
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CA
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Fed
X
X
X
X
X
CA
X
Fed
X
CA
X
X
X
X
X
X
Fed
X
X
CA
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
N/A
X
X
X
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
3RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
2WD
w/EGR**
4WD
w/oEGR**
3RZ–FE
5VZ–FE
T100
5VZ–FE
N/A
X
N/A
3RZ–FE
Land
Cruiser
4
SENSOR
EVAP
2RZ–FE
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
4Runner
3
Fed
2JZ-GTE
Sienna
2
X
2JZ–GE
3S FE
3S–FE
Tacoma
ATM
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
RAV4
1
CATALYST
X
MTM
Camry
y
Supra
CATEGORY
N/A
5S FE
5S–FE
Avalon
EGR
2WD
w/EGR**
2WD
or
4WD
w/oEGR**
N/A
2UZ–FE
* Readiness Monitor Drive Patterns:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
EGR (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
EGR (For 1FZ–FE Engine)
Catalyst (O2S Type)
Catalyst (AF Sensor Type)
EVAP (Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
EVAP (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
7. EVAP (Without Leak Detection)
8. EVAP (For Prius)
9. Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front & Rear O2S System)
10. Oxygen/AF Sensor Monitor (Front AF Sensor &
Rear O2S System)
11. Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
** Refer to Underhood Emissions Label on page 2.
Page 5 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive Pattern
Application
Tables
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NUMBER*
O2S/AF
MODEL
YEAR
DRIVE
TRAIN
CATEGORY
1
CATALYST
2
3
4
SENSOR
EVAP
5
6
7
8
9
10
HTR
11
MODEL
ENGINE
Tercel
5E–FE
X
X
X
X
X
Paseo
5E–FE
X
X
X
X
X
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
X
X
X
X
Celica
5S–FE
X
X
X
X
X
Fed
X
X
X
X
X
CA
X
N/A
5S FE
5S–FE
MTM
Camry
y
1MZ–FE
ATM
5S FE
5S–FE
1MZ–FE
Avalon
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
RAV4
3S FE
3S–FE
Sienna
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
ATM
X
X
X
X
X
X
Fed
X
X
X
X
X
CA
X
Fed
X
CA
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Fed
X
X
X
X
X
CA
X
Fed
X
CA
X
Fed
X
CA
X
Fed
CA
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
3RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
5VZ–FE
2WD
w/EGR**
2WD
or
4WD
w/oEGR**
3RZ–FE
Land
Cruiser
X
2RZ–FE
Tacoma
4Runner
X
X
MTM
Solara
1999
EGR
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
N/A
X
Fed
CA
X
N/A
2UZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
* Readiness Monitor Drive Patterns:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
EGR (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
EGR (For 1FZ–FE Engine)
Catalyst (O2S Type)
Catalyst (AF Sensor Type)
EVAP (Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
EVAP (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
** Refer to Underhood Emissions Label on page 2.
Page 6 of 23
7. EVAP (Without Leak Detection)
8. EVAP (For Prius)
9. Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front & Rear O2S System)
10. Oxygen/AF Sensor Monitor (Front AF Sensor &
Rear O2S System)
11. Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive Pattern
Application
Tables
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NUMBER*
O2S/AF
MODEL
YEAR
DRIVE
TRAIN
EGR
1
2
3
4
SENSOR
EVAP
5
6
7
8
9
10
HTR
11
MODEL
ENGINE
ECHO
1NZ–FE
X
X
X
X
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
2ZZ–GE
X
X
X
X
1ZZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
Celica
MR2
CATEGORY
CATALYST
1ZZ–FE
N/A
5S FE
5S–FE
Fed
X
CA
X
MTM
Camry
y
1MZ–FE
ATM
5S FE
5S–FE
1MZ–FE
Camry
CNG
5S–FNE
Avalon
1MZ–FE
ATM
3S FE
3S–FE
Sienna
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
X
Fed
X
X
X
X
X
CA
X
Fed
X
CA
X
Land
Cruiser
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CA
X
Fed
X
CA
X
w/EGR**
w/o A/F S,
w/oEGR**
w/A/F S,
w/oEGR**
3RZ–FE
Tundra
X
X
X
CA
2WD
or
4WD
X
X
3RZ–FE
4Runner
X
Fed
2RZ–FE
5VZ–FE
X
X
Fed
T
Tacoma
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
N/A
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
N/A
X
X
Fed
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Fed
X
X
CA
CA
X
N/A
N/A
2WD
X
X
X
2000
RAV4
X
X
MTM
Solara
X
X
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
2UZ–FE
X
X
X
X
2UZ–FE
X
X
X
X
* Readiness Monitor Drive Patterns:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
EGR (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
EGR (For 1FZ–FE Engine)
Catalyst (O2S Type)
Catalyst (AF Sensor Type)
EVAP (Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
EVAP (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
7. EVAP (Without Leak Detection)
8. EVAP (For Prius)
9. Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front & Rear O2S System)
10. Oxygen/AF Sensor Monitor (Front AF Sensor &
Rear O2S System)
11. Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
** Refer to Underhood Emissions Label on page 2.
Page 7 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive Pattern
Application
Tables
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NUMBER*
O2S/AF
MODEL
YEAR
DRIVE
TRAIN
EGR
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
HTR
11
ENGINE
ECHO
1NZ–FE
X
X
X
X
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
2ZZ–GE
X
X
X
X
1ZZ–FE
X
X
X
X
MR2
1ZZ–FE
N/A
5S–FE
Camry
y
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
X
Solara
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
Camry
CNG
5S–FNE
Avalon
1MZ–FE
Prius
1NZ-FXE
RAV4
1AZ–FE
High
Highlander
2AZ–FE
Sienna
Tacoma
Tundra
X
ATM
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
ATM
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
MTM
X
X
X
X
N/A
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1MZ–FE
X
X
X
X
1MZ–FE
X
X
X
X
N/A
2RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
3RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
4Runner
X
MTM
5S–FE
2001
1
SENSOR
EVAP
MODEL
Celica
CATEGORY
CATALYST
2WD
4WD
5VZ–FE
X
5VZ–FE
2UZ–FE
X
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Land
Cruiser
2UZ–FE
X
Sequoia
2UZ–FE
X
X
* Readiness Monitor Drive Patterns:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Page 8 of 23
EGR (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
EGR (For 1FZ–FE Engine)
Catalyst (O2S Type)
Catalyst (AF Sensor Type)
EVAP (Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
EVAP (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
7. EVAP (Without Leak Detection)
8. EVAP (For Prius)
9. Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front & Rear O2S System)
10. Oxygen/AF Sensor Monitor (Front AF Sensor &
Rear O2S System)
11. Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive Pattern
Application
Tables
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NUMBER*
O2S/AF
MODEL
YEAR
DRIVE
TRAIN
EGR
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
HTR
11
ENGINE
ECHO
1NZ–FE
X
X
X
X
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
MR2
1ZZ–FE
N/A
2ZZ–GE
1ZZ–FE
2AZ–FE
Camry
y
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
X
Solara
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
Camry
CNG
5S–FNE
Avalon
1MZ–FE
Prius
1NZ-FXE
RAV4
1AZ–FE
High
Highlander
2AZ–FE
Sienna
Tacoma
4Runner
Tundra
X
ATM
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
ATM
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
MTM
X
X
MTM
2AZ–FE
2002
SENSOR
EVAP
MODEL
Celica
CATEGORY
CATALYST
X
X
N/A
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1MZ–FE
X
X
X
X
1MZ–FE
X
X
X
X
N/A
2RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
3RZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
5VZ–FE
X
X
X
X
5VZ–FE
X
X
X
X
X
5VZ–FE
2UZ–FE
X
N/A
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Land
Cruiser
2UZ–FE
X
Sequoia
2UZ–FE
X
X
* Readiness Monitor Drive Patterns:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
EGR (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
EGR (For 1FZ–FE Engine)
Catalyst (O2S Type)
Catalyst (AF Sensor Type)
EVAP (Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
EVAP (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
7. EVAP (Without Leak Detection)
8. EVAP (For Prius)
9. Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front & Rear O2S System)
10. Oxygen/AF Sensor Monitor (Front AF Sensor &
Rear O2S System)
11. Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
Page 9 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EGR Monitors
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 1: EGR Monitor (All Except 1FZ–FE Engine)
43 – 56 mph
(70 – 90 km/h)
Idling
IG SW off
Warm up
10 min
(a)
3 – 5 min
(b)
3 – 5 min
(c)
3 – 5 min
3 – 5 min
(d)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.
IAT (Intake Air) is 14tF (–10tC) or greater.
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to the DLC3 connector to check monitor status and
preconditions.
a. If IAT (Intake Air) is less than 50tF (10tC) when starting the engine, idle the
engine for approximately 10 minutes.
b. Drive the vehicle at 43 – 56 mph (70 – 90 km/h) for a period of 3 – 5 minutes.
NOTE:
Do not allow the Throttle Position (TP) to exceed 30%.
Drive with smooth throttle operation and avoid sudden acceleration.
c. Stop the vehicle and let the engine idle for 3 – 5 minutes.
d. Repeat steps “b” and “c” once.
If readiness status does not switch to “complete,” ensure preconditions are met, turn the
ignition OFF, then repeat steps “b” through “d.”
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 10 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EGR Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 2: EGR Monitor (for 1FZ–FE Engine)
43 – 56 mph
(70 – 90 km/h)
Idling
IG SW off
3 – 5 min
(a)
3 – 5 min
(b)
3 – 5 min
3 – 5 min
(c)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.
IAT (Intake Air) is 14tF (–10tC) or greater.
ECT (Coolant Temp) is less than 104tF (40tC).
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
a. Start the engine and as soon as safely possible begin driving the vehicle at 43 –
56 mph (70 – 90 km/h) for a period of 3 – 5 minutes.
NOTE:
Do not allow the Throttle Position (TP) to exceed 30%.
Drive with smooth throttle operation and avoid sudden acceleration.
b. Stop the vehicle and let the engine idle for 3 – 5 minutes.
c. Repeat steps “a” and “b” once.
If readiness status does not switch to “complete,” ensure preconditions are met, turn the
ignition OFF, then repeat steps “a” through “c.”
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 11 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
Catalyst
Monitors
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 3: Catalyst Monitor (O2S Type)
40 – 50 mph
(64 – 88 km/h)
35 – 45 mph
(56 – 72 km/h)
Idling
IG SW off
Warm up
ECT≥176tF
IAT < 50tF = 7 min
IAT > 50tF = 3 min
(a)
7 min
(b)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
ECT (Coolant Temp) is 176tF (80tC) or greater.
IAT (Intake Air) is 14tF (–10tC) or greater.*
* For 2002 MY and later vehicles: The readiness test can be completed in cold ambient conditions
(less than 14tF / –10tC), if the drive pattern is repeated a second time after cycling the ignition OFF.
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
Note the IAT (Intake Air) value during engine startup. The driving time must be adjusted
during step “a” based upon IAT (Intake Air) value at startup.
a. Drive the vehicle at 40 – 55 mph (64 – 88 km/h) for the time described below:
If IAT (Intake Air) was less than 50tF (10tC) when the engine was started,
drive for 7 minutes.
If IAT (Intake Air) was greater than 50tF (10tC) when the engine was started,
drive for 3 minutes.
b. Drive the vehicle at 35 – 45 mph (56 – 72 km/h) for approximately 7 minutes.
NOTE:
Drive with smooth throttle operation.
Avoid sudden acceleration.
Avoid sudden deceleration as much as possible with the throttle fully closed.
If readiness status does not switch to “complete,” ensure preconditions are met, turn the
ignition OFF, then repeat steps “a” and “b.”
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 12 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
Catalyst
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 4: Catalyst Monitor (AF Sensor Type)
40 – 50 mph
(64 – 88 km/h)
35 – 45 mph
(56 – 72 km/h)
Idling
IG SW off
Warm up
ECT≥176tF
IAT < 50tF = 7min
IAT > 50tF = 3min
(a)
16 min
(b)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
ECT (Coolant Temp) is 176tF (80tC) or greater.
IAT (Intake Air) is 14tF (–10tC) or greater.*
* For 2002 MY and later vehicles: The readiness test can be completed in cold ambient conditions
(less than 14tF / –10tC), if the drive pattern is repeated a second time after cycling the ignition OFF.
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
Note the IAT (Intake Air) value during engine startup. The driving time must be adjusted
during step “a” based upon IAT (Intake Air) value at startup.
a. Drive the vehicle at 40 – 55 mph (64 – 88 km/h) for the time described below:
If IAT (Intake Air) was less than 50tF (10tC) when the engine was started,
drive for 7 minutes.
If IAT (Intake Air) was greater than 50tF (10tC) when the engine was started,
drive for 3 minutes.
b. Drive the vehicle allowing speed to fluctuate between 35 – 45 mph (56 – 72 km/h)
for about 16 minutes.
NOTE:
Drive with smooth throttle operation.
Avoid sudden acceleration.
Avoid sudden deceleration as much as possible with the throttle fully closed.
If readiness status does not switch to “complete,” ensure preconditions are met, turn the
ignition OFF, then repeat steps “a” and “b.”
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 13 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EVAP
Monitors
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 5: EVAP Monitor
(Internal Pressure Monitor/Non–Intrusive Type)
45 mph
(72 km/h)
25 mph
(40 km/h)
Idling
IG SW off
Warm up
ECT≥176tF
(1a)
Soak
(1b)
Cold Soak
5 min
(2a)
15 min
(2b)
Drive Pattern
Cold Soak Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Fuel level is between 1/2 to 3/4 full (for faster completion).
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.
IMPORTANT:
A cold soak must be performed prior to conducting the drive pattern to complete the
Internal Pressure Readiness Monitor.
Cold Soak Procedure
1a. Start the engine and allow ECT (Coolant Temp) to reach 176tF (80tC) or greater.
(This can be done by letting the engine idle or by driving the vehicle.)
1b. Let the vehicle cold soak for 8 hours or until the difference between IAT (Intake
Air) and ECT (Coolant Temp) is less than 13tF (7tC).
H Example 1
ECT (Coolant Temp) = 75tF (24tC).
IAT (Intake Air) = 60tF (16tC).
Difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is 15tF (8tC).
⇒ The monitor will not run because the difference between ECT (Coolant
Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is greater than 13tF (7tC).
H Example 2
ECT (Coolant Temp) = 70tF (21tC).
IAT (Intake Air) = 68tF (20tC).
Difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is 2tF (1tC).
⇒ The monitor will run because the difference between ECT (Coolant Temp)
and IAT (Intake Air) is less than 13tF (7tC).
Page 14 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EVAP
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
Drive Pattern Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Fuel level is between 1/2 to 3/4 full (for faster completion).
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.
ECT (Coolant Temp) is between 40tF and 95tF (4.4tC – 35tC).
IAT (Intake Air) is between 40tF and 95tF (4.4tC – 35tC).
Cold Soak Procedure has been completed.
NOTE:
Before starting the engine, the difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake
Air) must be less than 13tF (7tC). (Refer to Examples 1 and 2 on previous page.)
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
Release the pressure in the fuel tank by removing and then reinstalling the fuel tank
cap.
Start the engine and begin driving as directed.
NOTE:
Do not turn the ignition off until the drive pattern is complete.
Drive on smooth roads to reduce excessive fuel sloshing.
2a. Start the engine and as soon as safely possible begin driving at approximately 45
mph (72km/h) for 5 minutes. (See illustration on previous page.)
2b. Drive the vehicle at approximately 25 mph (40 km/h) for 15 minutes and include a
minimum of two stops for approximately 30 seconds. (See illustration on previous
page.)
The monitor should complete within approximately 20 minutes. If it does not, ensure
preconditions are met and repeat the drive pattern process beginning with the Cold Soak
Procedure.
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 15 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EVAP
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 6: EVAP Monitor (Vacuum Pressure Monitor/Intrusive Type)
3,000 rpm
Idling
IG SW off
Soak
(1a)
Warm up
(2a)
10 sec
(2b)
15 –50 min
(When the Readiness Monitor or
DTC is set, this test is complete.)
(2c)
Cold Soak Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Fuel level is between 1/2 to 3/4 full (for faster completion).
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.
Cold Soak Procedure
1a. Let the vehicle cold soak for 8 hours or until the difference between IAT (Intake
Air) and ECT (Coolant Temp) is less than 13tF (7tC).
H Example 1
ECT (Coolant Temp) = 75tF (24tC).
IAT (Intake Air) = 60tF (16tC).
Difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is 15tF (8tC).
⇒ The monitor will not run because the difference between ECT (Coolant
Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is greater than 13tF (7tC).
H Example 2
ECT (Coolant Temp) = 70tF (21tC).
IAT (Intake Air) = 68tF (20tC).
Difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is 2tF (1tC).
⇒ The monitor will run because the difference between ECT (Coolant Temp)
and IAT (Intake Air) is less than 13tF (7tC).
Page 16 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EVAP
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
Drive Pattern Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Fuel level is between 1/2 to 3/4 full (for faster completion).
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.*
ECT (Coolant Temp) is between 40tF and 95tF (4.4tC – 35tC).
IAT (Intake Air) is between 40tF and 95tF (4.4tC – 35tC).*
Cold Soak Procedure has been completed.
* For 2002 MY and later vehicles: The readiness test can be completed in cold ambient conditions
(less than 40tF / 4.4tC) and/or at high altitudes (more than 7800 feet / 2400 m) if the complete drive
pattern (including Cold Soak) is repeated a second time after cycling the ignition OFF.
NOTE:
Before starting the engine, the difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake
Air) must be less than 13tF (7tC). (Refer to Examples 1 and 2 on previous page.)
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
Release the pressure in the fuel tank by removing and then reinstalling the fuel tank
cap.
2a. Start the engine and allow it to idle until ECT (Coolant Temp) is 167tF (75tC) or
greater. (See illustration on previous page.)
2b. Race the engine at 3,000 rpm for approximately 10 seconds. (See illustration on
previous page.)
2c. Allow the engine to idle with the A/C ON (to create a slight load) for 15 – 50
minutes. (See illustration on previous page.)
NOTE:
If the vehicle is not equipped with A/C put a slight load on the engine by doing the
following:
Securely set the parking brake.
Block the drive wheels with wheel chocks.
Allow the vehicle to idle in drive for 15 – 50 minutes.
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 17 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EVAP
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 7: EVAP Monitor (Without Leak Detection)
43 – 56 mph
(70 – 90 km/h)
Idling
IG SW off
Warm up
ECT≥181tF
3 – 5 min
(a)
3 – 5 min
(b)
3 – 5 min
3 – 5 min
(c)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.
ECT (Coolant Temp) is 181tF (83tC) or greater.
IAT (Intake Air) is 41tF (5tC) or greater.
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
a. Drive the vehicle at 43 – 56 mph (70 – 90 km/h) for a period of 3 – 5 minutes.
NOTE:
Do not allow the Throttle Position (TP) to exceed 30%.
Drive with smooth throttle operation and avoid sudden acceleration.
b. Stop the vehicle and let the engine idle for 3 – 5 minutes.
c. Repeat steps “a” and “b” once.
If readiness status does not switch to “complete,” ensure preconditions are met, turn the
ignition OFF, then repeat steps “a” through “c.”
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 18 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EVAP
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 8: EVAP Monitor (For Prius)
50 – 65 mph
(80 – 104 km/h)
Idling
IG SW off
Soak
(1a)
15 min
(When the Readiness Monitor or
DTC is set, this test is complete.)
(2a)
Cold Soak Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.
IMPORTANT:
A cold soak must be performed prior to conducting the drive pattern to complete the
Internal Pressure Readiness Monitor.
Cold Soak Procedure
1a. Let the vehicle cold soak for 8 hours or until the difference between IAT (Intake
Air) and ECT (Coolant Temp) is less than 13tF (7tC).
H Example 1
ECT (Coolant Temp) = 75tF (24tC).
IAT (Intake Air) = 60tF (16tC).
Difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is 15tF (8tC).
⇒ The monitor will not run because the difference between ECT (Coolant
Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is greater than 13tF (7tC).
H Example 2
ECT (Coolant Temp) = 70tF (21tC).
IAT (Intake Air) = 68tF (20tC).
Difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake Air) is 2tF (1tC).
⇒ The monitor will run because the difference between ECT (Coolant Temp)
and IAT (Intake Air) is less than 13tF (7tC).
Page 19 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
EVAP
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
Drive Pattern Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Altitude is 7800 feet (2400 m) or less.
ECT (Coolant Temp) is between 40tF and 95tF (4.4tC – 35tC).
IAT (Intake Air) is between 40tF and 95tF (4.4tC – 35tC).*
Cold Soak Procedure has been completed.
NOTE:
Before starting the engine, the difference between ECT (Coolant Temp) and IAT (Intake
Air) must be less than 13tF (7tC). (Refer to Examples 1 and 2 on previous page.)
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
Release the pressure in the fuel tank by removing and then reinstalling the fuel tank
cap.
Start the engine and as soon as safely possible begin driving as directed.
2a. Drive the vehicle at 50 – 65 mph (80 – 104 km/h) for about 15 minutes. (See
illustration on previous page.)
NOTE:
Do not turn the ignition off until the drive pattern is complete.
Drive on smooth roads to reduce excessive fuel sloshing.
If vehicle speed drops under 45 mph (72 km/h) repeat step “2a.”
Page 20 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
Oxygen
Monitors
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 9: Oxygen Sensor Monitor (Front and Rear O2S System)
Once
Twice
3 times
10 times
25 mph
(40 km/h)
(over 900
rpm)
Idling
IG SW off
Over
2 min
(a)
Over
50 sec
(b)
Over
40
sec
(c)
Over
50 sec
Over
40
sec
50 sec
40
sec
50 sec
(d)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
a. Start the engine and allow it to idle for 2 minutes or more.
b. Drive the vehicle at 25 mph (40 km/h) or more for at least 50 seconds.
Be sure engine speed remains above 900 rpm.
c. Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for 40 seconds or more.
d. Perform steps “b” and “c” ten times.
If readiness status does not switch to “complete,” ensure preconditions are met, turn the
ignition OFF, then repeat steps “a” through “d.”
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 21 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
Oxygen
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 10: Oxygen/Air Fuel Ratio Sensor Monitor
(Front AF Sensor and Rear O2S System)
40 – 70 mph
(64 – 112 km/h)
(900 – 3,200 rpm)
Once
25 mph
(40 km/h)
(over 900 rpm)
Twice
10 times
Over
40 sec
40 sec
Idling
IG SW off
Over
2 min
(a)
Over
3 min
(b)
Over
40 sec
(d)
Over
Over
10 sec
10 sec
(c)
(e)
Over
10 sec
(f)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
a. Start the engine and allow it to idle for 2 minutes or more.
b. Drive the vehicle at 40 – 70 mph (64 – 112 km/h) or more for at least 3 minutes.
Be sure to maintain engine speed between 900 and 3,200 rpm.
c. Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for 10 seconds or more.
d. Drive the vehicle at 25 mph (40 km/h) for at least 40 seconds or more.
Be sure to maintain engine speed above 900 rpm.
e. Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for 10 seconds or more.
f.
Perform steps “d” and “e” ten times.
If readiness status does not switch to “complete,” ensure preconditions are met, turn the
ignition switch OFF, then repeat steps “a” through “f.”
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 22 of 23
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE PATTERNS – EG003-02 Revised
Readiness
Monitor
Drive
Patterns:
Oxygen
Monitors
(Continued)
March 29, 2002
DRIVE PATTERN NO. 11: Oxygen/AF Sensor Heater Monitor
25 mph
(40 km/h)
Idling
IG SW off
9 min
(a)
2 min
(b)
Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
Drive Pattern Procedure
Connect the OBDII Scantool to DLC3 to check monitor status and preconditions.
a. Start the engine and allow it to idle for 9 minutes.
b. Drive the vehicle at 25 mph (40 km/h) or more for at least 2 minutes.
If readiness status does not switch to “complete,” ensure preconditions are met, turn the
ignition OFF, then repeat steps “a” and “b.”
NOTE:
The readiness status may not switch to “complete” after the first drive pattern trip if a
Pending Code has been set (first trip for a two–trip DTC).
Pending Codes are available from the DTC Info Menu in Enhanced OBDII.
Pending Codes indicate a POTENTIAL problem was detected. A second trip is
needed to confirm the DTC prior to diagnosis.
Once a second trip is completed, a current DTC will be stored.
Page 23 of 23
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SULFUR ODOR FROM EXHAUST
Models:
All Models
February 24, 2003
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Repair
Procedure
Some owners of Toyota vehicles may experience a sulfur–like or “rotten egg” odor from
the exhaust system. Sulfur is a natural component of crude oil from which gasoline is
refined and the amount of sulfur can be decreased through the refining process. The
amount of sulfur in fuel sold in California is regulated, however gasoline sold in other
states can have substantially higher sulfur content. Sulfur content also varies
considerably between gasoline brands and locations.
S All Models.
A sulfur odor emitted from the vehicle’s tailpipe does not necessarily indicate that there is
an issue with the engine’s running condition, but is most likely directly related to the fuel.
If the vehicle is exhibiting an excessive sulfur odor, the following checks should be
performed:
S If the MIL light is ON, check for DTCs and repair as necessary.
If no trouble is found after performing the above check, recommend the customer try a
different source of fuel.
Replacement of oxygen sensors, air/fuel ratio sensors or catalytic converters will not
reduce the odor and will therefore not be considered warrantable.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
ENGINE
EG003-03
Title:
’99 Avalon, Camry & Solara
June 11, 1999
Introduction
Under certain driving conditions, some 1999 Model
Year Avalon, Camry and Solaras will
exhibit a false M.I.L. ON DTC P0446.
A Vacuum Control Valve Assembly has been
developed to prevent this condition.
Production
Change
Information
VIN RANGE
MODEL
FROM
TO
4T1BF1#B*XU286982
4T1BF1#B*XU307913
JT2BG2#K*X0263387
JT2BG2#K*X0301683
4T1BG2#K*XU382466
4T1BG2#K*XU446663
4T1BG2#K*XU859688
4T1BG2#K*XU890371
JT2BF2#K*X0146113
JT2BF2#K*X0164251
4T1BF2#K*XU074015
4T1BF2#K*XU077714
4T1BF2#K*XU929580
4T1BF2#K*XU079278
Camry Solara
2T1CG2#P*XC055458
2T1CG2#P*XC142298
(4 Cylinder)
2T1CG2#P*XC736206
2T1CG2#P*XC766681
2T1CF2#P*XC055463
2T1CF2#P*XC142355
2T1CF2#P*XC722383
2T1CF2#P*XC766715
Avalon
Camry
(4 Cylinder)
Camry
(6 Cylinder)
Camry Solara
(6 Cylinder)
”#” May be a 2 or an 8.
”*” May be any number from 0 to 9 or an X.
Parts
Information
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
N/A
Warranty
OPCODE
Information
8602L2
CURRENT PART NUMBER
25852-20010
DESCRIPTION
Vacuum Control Valve
PART NAME
Valve, Vacuum Control with Hoses
TIME
0.5
OPN
25852-20010
T1
T2
99 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect
for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle s in-service
date. Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in
the states of California and Massachusetts under the California Emission Warranty.
*
Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer s specific complaint.
NOTE:
Please enter the DTC P0446 in the Condition/Cause/Remedy Section when applying
for Warranty Reimbursement.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1of 2
ENGINE
TSB
DIAGNOSTIC TR OUBLE CODE P0446
Models:
EG004-99
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Title:
R E V I S E D
TOYOTA
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE P0446
Repair
Procedure
– EG004-99 Revised
1. Verify that the Purge System is
operating as specified in the Repair
Manual.
June 11, 1999
Figure 1
2. Raise vehicle on lift to gain access to
the Purge Canister and remove the two
Vacuum Lines indicated in Figure 1.
Remove
Save the Metal Clamps from the larger
hoses for reuse.
Use these two clamps on
the New Hose Assembly
3. Install the New Hose Assembly as
shown in Figure 2.
Figure 2
Reuse the Hose Clamps removed in
Step 2 on the large hose as indicated.
Drain
Hose
Thin
Hose
Thick Hose to
Canister
Clamp must be
above Hose and
clamped onto Wire
Harness
Clamp onto
Drain Hose
Use Metal
Clamps here
Bottom of Vehicle
4. Verify that the Vacuum Hose Assembly
is installed as shown in Figure 3.
Figure 3
Route Larger Hose under
Smaller Vacuum Hose.
5. After lowering vehicle verify that the
Gas Cap is on securely.
Rear of Vehicle
Metal Tube attached to
side of Body.
Install the Two Clamps
removed in Step "2" here.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
M.I.L. ON" P1133
Models:
’97–’99 Camry and ’99 Solara
April 20, 2001
Introduction
Under certain driving conditions, some 1997 – 1999 5S–FE California emission
specification Camrys and 1999 5S–FE California emission specification Solaras may
exhibit a M.I.L. “ON” with DTC P1133 (Air Fuel Ratio Sensor Slow Response
Malfunction). An improved Air Fuel Ratio (A/F) Sensor was developed to correct this
condition (See TSB EG006–99).
In some rare cases, P1133 may still set after the improved A/F sensor is installed. The
Engine Control Module (ECM) logic has been modified to correct this condition.
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
S 1997 – 1999 model year Camrys with 5S–FE California emission specification.
S 1999 model year Solaras with 5S–FE California emission specification.
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
89661–3T451
89661–3T452
ECM,, 1999 AT
89661–06681
89661–06682
ECM,, 1999 MT
89661–3T271
89661–3T272
ECM,, 1998 AT
89661–06501
89661–06502
ECM,, 1998 MT
89661–3T041
89661–3T042
ECM, 1997 AT
89661–06371
89661–06372
ECM, 1997 MT
89661–3T471
89661–3T472
ECM, 1999 AT
89661–3T291
89661–3T292
ECM, 1998 AT
Non Immobilizer
Non–Immobilizer
Immobilizer
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
895011
Varied Work Code “N”.
R & R ECM For DOHC
0.4
See Previous PN
Above
T2
99 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Federal Emissions Warranty. This warranty is
in effect for 96 months or 80,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ENGINE
EG004-01
Title:
M.I.L. “ON” P1133 – EG004-01
Repair
Procedure
April 20, 2001
1. Should a M.I.L. “ON” condition with P1133 be encountered, perform diagnostic
procedures as described in the Repair Manual.
2. If the problem source cannot be identified after checking all affected areas according
to the Repair Manual, the cause may be an A/F Sensor or ECM logic malfunction. In
this case, follow the procedure in the flowchart below to determine which part needs
to be replaced.
Replace the ECM only if the A/F Sensor in the vehicle was produced after
August 31, 1999.
DATE CODE
PART NUMBER
Check A/F Sensor Part Number
If 89467–33010:
Replace sensor with 89467–33011
If 89467–33011:
Check A/F Sensor
Date Code Number:
If sensor was built before
Aug. 31, 1999,
Date Code 08U31:
Replace with sensor built after
Date Code 08U31.
If sensor was built after
Aug. 31, 1999,
Date Code 08U31:
Replace ECM with the improved
one.
A/F Sensor Date Code Number:
08 U 31
Month
08 = Aug.
Year
U = 1999
B = 2000
Page 2 of 2
Day
Date Code Examples:
07U25 = July 25, 1999
02B15 = February 15, 2000
Technical Service
BULLETIN
April 27, 2001
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Contents
Warranty
Information
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION
INFORMATION
Models:
All ’96 – ’01 Models
This service bulletin provides supplemental information regarding the system design,
operation, and diagnostics of the Early Type (Non–Intrusive) and Late Type (Intrusive)
EVAP Systems found on 1996 model year and later OBD II equipped vehicles.
MODEL
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
Avalon
Early
Early
Early
Early
Late
Late
Camry
Early
(A/T only)
Early
Early
Early
Late
Late
Camry
Solara
N/A
N/A
N/A
Early
Late
Late
Celica
N/A
N/A
Early
Early
Late
Late
Corolla
N/A
N/A
Early
Early
Late
Late
ECHO
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Late
Late
MR2
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Late
Late
Prius
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Late
Late
Tercel
N/A
Early
Early
Early
N/A
N/A
4Runner
Early
Early
Early
Early
Early
Late
Land
Cruiser
N/A
N/A
Early
Early
Early
Early
RAV4
Early
Early
Early
Early
Early
Late
Sequoia
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Late
Sienna
N/A
N/A
Early
Early
Early
Late
Tacoma
Early
(4WD only)
Early
Early
Early
Early
Early
Tundra
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Early
Early
T100
N/A
Early
Early
N/A
N/A
N/A
This bulletin is divided into the following sections:
Early Type and Late Type EVAP System Outline
1. Early Type Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2. Late Type Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3. ECHO Late Type Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4. Late Type System Monitor Sequence . . . . . .
Diagnostic Tips For Late Type EVAP System . . . . . . . . . .
Pages 2–4
Pages 4–6
Page 6
Pages 6–9
Pages 10–14
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 14
ENGINE
EG005-01
Title:
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Early Type
System
Description
April 27, 2001
Early Type (Non–Intrusive) EVAP System Overview
There are a variety of EVAP systems in use with different monitoring strategies. It is
essential that the EVAP system be correctly identified before beginning diagnosis. The
Repair Manual is the best source for this information. The following information covers
the different systems.
The first system described is the Early Type (Non–Intrusive) EVAP System. Refer to the
Applicable Vehicles chart for applicability information.
Onboard Recovery Valve
(Fill Check Valve)
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Three Way
VSV
Vacuum
Check
Valve
Tank Valve
Assembly
Pressure
Valve
Canister
To
Manifold
Vacuum
Purge
Valve
Filtered
Air
Air Inlet Line
Service
Port
Air Drain Valve
Air Inlet Valve
Air Valve Assembly
Purge Operation
When the engine has reached
predetermined parameters (closed loop,
engine temp. above 125F, etc.), stored
fuel vapors are purged from the canister
whenever the purge VSV is opened by
the ECM. At the appropriate time, the
ECM will turn on the purge VSV.
Purge VSV
Fresh Air Inlet
The ECM will change the duty ratio cycle
of the purge VSV thus controlling purge
flow volume. Purge flow volume is
determined by manifold pressure and the
duty ratio cycle of the purge VSV.
Atmospheric pressure is allowed into the
canister to ensure that purge flow is
constantly maintained whenever purge
vacuum is applied to the canister (see
Figure 1).
Page 2 of 14
Figure 1. Purge Operation
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Early Type
System
Description
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
ORVR Operation
During refueling, low pressure above the
diaphragm in the onboard recovery valve
lifts allowing fuel vapors into the charcoal
canister. At the same time, the air drain
valve opens and the charcoal absorbs the
fuel vapors (see Figure 2).
Figure 2. ORVR Operation
Early Type (Non–Intrusive) EVAP System DTCs
EVAP Monitor Leak Operation P0440
The ECM tests for leaks by measuring
EVAP system pressure in the lines,
charcoal canister, and fuel tank. When
the EVAP pressure is higher or lower than
atmospheric pressure, the ECM
concludes that no leaks are present.
EVAP pressure is measured by the vapor
pressure sensor. If either the tank or
canister purge side is at atmospheric
pressure under specific conditions, the
ECM determines there is a leak.
Figure 3. Fuel Tank Side of System
If DTC P0440 is present, the leak is on
the fuel tank side of the EVAP system.
This also includes the lines between the
fuel tank and part of the canister. When
the Vapor Pressure sensor is measuring
tank pressure, the ECM is observing
changes in pressure and comparing tank
pressure to atmospheric pressure. No
difference in pressure indicates a leak.
The ECM may take 20 minutes or more to
complete testing the fuel tank side (see
Figure 3).
Canister Leak Detection P0446
When the ECM switches the vapor
pressure VSV to canister side, the ECM
measures canister pressure. A leak on
the canister side can set multiple DTCs
(see Figure 4).
Figure 4. Canister Side of System
Page 3 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Early Type
System
Description
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
Vapor Purge Flow P0441
The EVAP monitor is designed to detect:
S Restricted vapor purge flow when the
purge VSV is open
S Inappropriate vapor purge flow when
the purge VSV is closed
Under normal purge conditions, pressure
pulsations generated by the cycling of the
purge VSV are present in the canister
and detected by the Vapor Pressure
sensor.
Figure 5. Flow During Purge Operation
Three–Way VSV P0446
The three–way VSV is connected to the Vapor Pressure sensor, canister, and fuel tank.
This VSV allows the Vapor Pressure sensor to detect either canister or tank pressure.
There are two modes the ECM can use to determine if the three–way VSV is
malfunctioning. The three–way VSV is judged to be normal if there is pressure difference
between the tank and canister when the three–way VSV is switched to look at the
charcoal canister and fuel tank side of system.
If there isn’t any pressure difference between the fuel tank and canister, the ECM looks
for the following conditions:
S During purging, pressure pulsations generated by the purge VSV are not present in
the canister as detected by Vapor Pressure sensor, the three–way VSV is judged to
be defective.
S If there are pressure pulsations detected by the Vapor Pressure sensor present in the
fuel tank, the three–way VSV is judged to be defective.
Late Type
System
Description
Late Type (Intrusive) EVAP System Overview
The Late Type EVAP System, also known as the Intrusive type, was developed to meet
the very stringent, mandated standard of detecting a hole 0.020 inch (0.5 mm). This
system uses many of the same components as the early type EVAP system. Purge,
vacuum relief, pressure relief, and ORVR operations are identical to the early type. Refer
to the Applicable Vehicles chart for applicability information.
The following changes were made to the Late Type EVAP System:
S Vapor pressure sensor connected to the fuel tank.
S Bypass VSV in the place of the three way VSV.
S Canister Closed Valve (CCV) on the air inlet line.
Page 4 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Late Type
System
Description
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
Late Type (Intrusive EVAP System) (Except ECHO)
Onboard Recovery Valve
(Fill Check Valve)
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Vacuum
Check
Valve
Tank Valve
Assembly
Tank
Pressure
Valve
Canister
To
Manifold
Vacuum
Purge
VSV
Filtered
Air
Canister
Closed Valve
Service
Port
Bypass
VSV
Air
Inlet Line
Air Inlet Valve
Air Drain Valve
Tank Side
The bypass VSV and the fill check valve
assembly isolates the tank pressure side
from the canister side (see Figure 1).
Air Valve Assembly
Except ECHO
Figure 1. Fuel Tank Side of System
Canister Side
The bypass VSV and the Fill Check valve
also isolate the canister side from the
tank side (see Figure 2).
Except ECHO
Figure 2. Canister Side of System
Page 5 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Late Type
System
Description
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
ECHO Late Type (Intrusive EVAP System)
The ECHO uses a Late Type EVAP System but is configured with some small
differences. For the ECHO, the Canister Closed Valve is located directly on the canister.
Additionally, the bypass VSV has been eliminated.
Onboard Recovery
Valve (Fill Check Valve)
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Canister
Air Inlet Valve
To
Manifold
Vacuum
Purge
Valve
Filtered
Air
Canister Closed Valve
Air Drain Valve Assembly
Late Type
System
Monitor
Sequence
Air Valve Assembly
Late Type (Intrusive) EVAP System Monitor Sequence
The monitoring sequence for leak detection is different from that of the Early Type EVAP
System. The Late Type applies a very small vacuum to the EVAP system. The ECM then
determines if there is a problem in the system based on the vapor pressure sensor
signal.
Monitor Sequence (Except ECHO)
Open
CCV Open
Closed
Open
Bypass Closed
Closed
Open
Open
Purge Closed
Purge Closed
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Signal
Time in Minutes
Cold Start ECT/IAT
Near Same Temp
Negative
Pressure
(Vacuum)
Occurs
P0441
Page 6 of 14
Leak Testing CCV Bypass
VSV Op
Period Occurs Op
P0440
P0442
P0446
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Late Type
System
Monitor
Sequence
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
ECHO Monitor Sequence
Open
CCV Open
Closed
Open
Open
Purge Closed
Purge
Closed
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Signal
Cold Start ECT/IAT
Near Same Temp
Negative
Pressure
(Vacuum)
Occurs
Tank &
Canister
Leak Check
CCV
Testing
Monitor Operation
The monitor sequence begins with a cold
engine start. The IAT and ECT sensors
must have approximately the same
temperature reading.
The ECM is constantly monitoring fuel
tank pressure. As the temperature of the
fuel increases, pressure slowly rises.
Except ECHO
Figure 1. Canister Purge
The ECM will purge the charcoal canister
at the appropriate time (see Figure 1).
With bypass VSV closed, pressure will
continue to rise in fuel tank.
ECHO
Figure 1. Canister Purge
Page 7 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Late Type
System
Monitor
Sequence
(Continued)
Purge VSV Operation – P0441
At a predetermined point, the ECM closes
the CCV and opens the bypass VSV
causing vacuum to increase in the entire
EVAP system.
The ECM continues to operate the purge
VSV until the vacuum is increased to a
specified point at which time the ECM
closes the purge VSV (see Figure 2).
If the vacuum did not increase, or if the
vacuum increased beyond the specified
limit, the ECM judges the purge VSV and
related components to be faulty.
April 27, 2001
Except ECHO
Figure 2. Vacuum Application
ECHO
Figure 2. Vacuum Application
Hole Detection P0440 and P0442
The rate of pressure increase as detected
by the vapor pressure signal indicates the
if there is a leak and if it is a large or
small leak.
After purge VSV operation, the purge
VSV is turned off sealing the vacuum in
the system and the ECM begins to
monitor the pressure increase (see Figure
3). Some increase is normal. A very rapid,
sharp increase in pressure indicates a
leak in the EVAP system and sets the
DTC P0440.
Except ECHO
Figure 3. System Sealed
ECHO
This monitoring method is also able to
distinguish what is called the small leak
detection. A pressure rise just above
normal indicates a very small hole and
will set the DTC P0442.
Figure 3. System Sealed
Page 8 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Late Type
System
Monitor
Sequence
(Continued)
Vent Control, CCV Operation P0446
This stage checks the CCV and vent (air
inlet side) operation. When the vapor
pressure rises to a specified point, the
ECM opens the CCV. Pressure will
increase rapidly because of the air
allowed into the system. No increase or
an increase below specified rate of
pressure increase indicates a restriction
on the air inlet side (see Figure 4).
April 27, 2001
Except ECHO
Figure 4. CCV Opens
ECHO
Figure 4. CCV Opens
Bypass VSV Operation P0446
In the next stage, the ECM closes the
bypass VSV. This action blocks air
entering the tank side of the system. The
pressure rise on the fuel tank side is no
longer as great. If there was no change in
pressure, the ECM will conclude the
bypass VSV did not close (see Figure 5).
Except ECHO
Figure 5. Bypass VSV Closes
Page 9 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Diagnostic
Tips for Late
Type EVAP
System
April 27, 2001
This diagnostic process tests the EVAP System. The following diagnostic tips may be
used in conjunction with the Diagnostic Procedures for EVAP DTCs listed in the Repair
Manual. They may be used for all Late Type (Intrusive) EVAP Systems and for all EVAP
DTCs. Refer to the Applicable Vehicles chart for applicability information.
The EVAP System Pressure Test Kit (P/N 00002–6872A) and the Scan Tool can be used
to diagnose the EVAP System. Measuring EVAP System pressures using the EVAP
System Pressure Tester Gauge and the Scan Tool can aid in the identification of leaks in
the system.
System Outline (Except ECHO)
Onboard Recovery Valve
(Fill Check Valve)
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Tank Valve
Assembly
Vacuum
Check
Valve
Tank
Pressure
Valve
Canister
To
Manifold
Vacuum
Purge
VSV
Filtered
Air
Canister
Closed Valve
Service
Port
Bypass
VSV
Air
Inlet Line
Air Inlet Valve
Air Valve Assembly
Air Drain Valve
ECHO System Outline
Onboard Recovery Valve
(Fill Check Valve)
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Air Inlet Valve
Canister
To
Manifold
Vacuum
Purge
VSV
Filtered
Air
Service
Port
Page 10 of 14
Air
Inlet Line
Air Drain
Valve
Air Valve
Assembly
Canister
Closed
Valve
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Diagnostic
Tips for Late
Type EVAP
System
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
Diagnostic Process Flow Chart
START
PRELIMINARY CHECK
S Fuel level should be between
1/4 and 3/4
S Visually inspect for presence
of Fuel/Gas Cap
DO NOT TIGHTEN OR REMOVE!
NG
DO NOT PROCEED!
OK
SCAN TOOL SETUP
A) Connect Scan Tool to DLC3 on vehicle.
B) Go to the SETUP menu and select UNIT CONVERSION.
C) Under VAPOR PRESSURE, Select ABS for absolute pressure, and mmHg for millimeters of mercury.
This is to match the Repair Manual specifications.
D) Go back to FUNCTION SELECT menu and select ENHANCED OBD II.
E) Select NORMAL MODE. Then select CURRENT DATA and USER SELECT.
F) Using the arrow key, select VAPOR PRESS from the DATA LIST and select YES.
G) Press ENTER. You will now be able to monitor the Vapor Pressure Sensor reading.
If vehicle is ECHO, go directly to “ECHO Canister and Tank Leak Check” on page 14.
If vehicle is not ECHO, follow the flow chart below.
PRESSURIZE EVAP SYSTEM (System Integrity Check)
This test checks for leaks in the canister and fuel tank sides. The CCV and Air Inlet Lines will be checked
separately.
A) Clamp the air drain hose on the charcoal canister with the supplied hose pliers from the EVAP System
Pressure Test Kit.
B) Locate the vapor pressure sensor. If the vapor pressure sensor has two hoses connected to it,
disconnect the hose between the air drain hose fitting at the vapor pressure sensor and plug the hose.
C) Connect the pressure supply hose from the Pressure Test Kit to the Green EVAP System Service Port
located on the EVAP Purge VSV line in the engine compartment.
D) Using the directions on the inside of the EVAP System Pressure Test Kit lid, pressurize the EVAP
system. Once pressurized, turn off the pump and seal the system (Pressure Hold Switch to “Closed”
and Vent Switch to “Closed).
E) After 30 seconds, note the pump pressure gauge reading and the Scan Tool vapor pressure
sensor reading.
F) Compare the readings to one of the four conditions listed below and proceed as directed.
(Continued on following page)
Page 11 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Diagnostic
Tips for Late
Type EVAP
System
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
Diagnostic Process Flow Chart (Continued)
(Continued from previous page)
Pump pressure
gauge and vapor
pressure above
atmospheric
pressure (above 762
mmHg). No leak in
canister or tank.
Pump pressure
gauge zero, vapor
pressure above
atmospheric
pressure (above 762
mmHg). Leak is on
canister side of
system.
Pump pressure
gauge is above
atmospheric
pressure (above
zero), vapor
pressure is at
762 mmHg. Leak is
on the fuel tank side
of system.
Pump pressure
gauge at zero,
vapor pressure is
at 762 mmHg. The
leak(s) is/are on the
canister and tank
sides or a leak at a
point common to
both sides of system.
Remove hose pliers
from the air drain
hose on the charcoal
canister before
proceeding with
additional checks.
Remove hose pliers
from the air drain
hose on the charcoal
canister before
proceeding with
additional checks.
Remove hose pliers
from the air drain
hose on the charcoal
canister before
proceeding with
additional checks.
Remove hose pliers
from the air drain
hose on the charcoal
canister before
proceeding with
additional checks.
Go to CCV/Air Inlet
Line Check.
Go to “Canister Leak
Check.” Diagram on
page 13.
Go to “Fuel Tank
Leak Check.”
Diagram on page 13.
Go to “Fuel Tank
Leak Check.”
Diagram on page 13.
CCV and Air Inlet Line Check. (Except ECHO)
A) Disconnect the air inlet line from the charcoal canister.
B) Using the supplied step–down brass adapter (or equivalent) connect the Pressure Supply Hose to
the air inlet line.
C) Using the Scan Tool Active Test, turn on the CCV. This will close the CCV.
D) Pressurize the line. Once pressurized, turn off the pump and seal the line (Pressure Hold Switch to
“Closed” and Vent Switch to “Closed”). Pressure should hold. If not, check CCV and connections.
E) Next, using the Scan Tool, turn off the CCV. This will open the CCV. The pressure should decrease.
If not, check the CCV and connections.
F) After completing the test, reconnect air inlet line to charcoal canister.
Go to “Return Vehicle to Service” on page 14.
Page 12 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Diagnostic
Tips for Late
Type EVAP
System
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
Fuel Tank Leak Check (Except ECHO)
Disconnect
EVAP Hose Here
A. Using the supplied brass step–down adapter, disconnect the EVAP hose from
the charcoal canister side as indicated above. Connect Pressure Supply hose
from Pressure Test Kit to the EVAP hose and pressurize the fuel tank to
30 mmHg (4 kPa / 0.58 psi).
B. Check that the internal pressure of the tank will hold for 1 minute. Check shaded
areas for leaks (soapy water can be used for leak detection). If pressure holds, then
perform the Canister Leak Check.
C. When done, reconnect the EVAP line hose to the charcoal canister.
Canister Leak Check (Except ECHO)
A. Connect the Pressure Supply hose from the Pressure Test Kit to the Green EVAP
System Service Port located on the EVAP Purge VSV line in the engine compartment.
B. Using the directions on the inside of the EVAP System Pressure Test Kit lid,
pressurize the EVAP system. Once pressurized, turn off the pump and seal the system
(Pressure Hold Switch to “Closed” and Vent Switch to “Closed”)
C. With system pressurized at EVAP Service Port, check shaded areas for leaks (soapy
water can be used for leak detection).
Page 13 of 14
EVAP SYSTEM OPERATION INFORMATION – EG005-01
Diagnostic
Tips for Late
Type EVAP
System
(Continued)
April 27, 2001
ECHO Canister and Tank Leak Check
A. Connect the Pressure Supply hose from the Pressure Test Kit to the Green EVAP
System Service Port located on the EVAP Purge VSV line in the engine
compartment.
B. Using the directions on the inside of the EVAP System Pressure Test Kit lid,
pressurize the EVAP system. Once pressurized, turn off the pump and seal the
system (Pressure Hold Switch to “Closed” and Vent Switch to “Closed”)
C. With system pressurized, check shaded areas for leaks (soapy water can be used
for leak detection).
Return Vehicle to Service
A. After performing checks and/or repairs, be sure to reconnect all lines and verify
that all plugs and hose pliers used for diagnosis have been removed.
B. For additional diagnostic procedures and information, refer to the appropriate
Repair Manual.
Page 14 of 14
Technical Service
BULLETIN
GENERAL MAINTENANCE TIP
Models:
All ’93 – ’03 Models
March 22, 2002
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Oil Filling
Procedure
To help prevent unnecessary complications during the oil fill process, no undue load
should be placed on the oil baffle attached to the inside of the valve cover (see
illustration). This baffle is designed to deflect oil and should not be used to support
the weight of heavy oil fill devices. These devices can place stress on the baffle, and
bend or break it during the oil fill process.
S All 1993 – 2003 model year Toyota vehicles.
Please take measures to ensure that the baffle is not damaged during the oil fill process.
If it does become damaged, repair it before any collateral damage occurs.
Oil Fill Gun
Valve
Cover
Example of Bent Oil Baffle
(View From Underneath Valve Cover)
Oil Baffle
Bent
Oil Baffle
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
ENGINE
EG007-02
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
M.I.L. ON" P0440, P0441 & P0446
Models:
’98 – ’99 Camry & Solara
July 12, 2002
Introduction
Under certain driving conditions, some 1998 – 1999 model year Camry and Solara
vehicles may exhibit a M.I.L. “ON” with DTCs P0440, P0441 and P0446 stored due to an
inoperative Vapor Pressure Sensor 3 way Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV). An improved
Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV has been developed to correct this condition.
1998 – 1999 model year Camry & Solara vehicles.
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
Required Tools
& Material
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QTY
90910–12109
90910–12271
Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV
1
TOOLS & MATERIAL
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
01001271
1
01002593-005
1
Hand Operated Vacuum Pump
N/A
1
Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM)
09082–00050
(Or Equivalent)
1
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit*
12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
with version 9.01a Software (or later)*
*
Essential SSTs.
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, Program Cards or SSTs may be ordered by calling
OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
178011
DESCRIPTION
TIME
R & R Vacuum Switching Valve (4 Cylinder)
0.4
R & R Vacuum Switching Valve (6 Cylinder)
0.2
OFP
90910 12109
90910–12109
T1
T2
72 83
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Comprehensive Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 5
ENGINE
EG013-02
Title:
M.I.L. “ON” P0440, P0441 & P0446 – EG013-02
Inspection &
Repair
Procedure
July 12, 2002
Test VSV Operation Using ACTIVE TEST on the Toyota Diagnostic Tester
1. Test operation of the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV using the Toyota Diagnostic Tester
in ACTIVE TEST (see screen flow in Figure 1).
Figure 1: Testing Operation of Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV using ACTIVE TEST
A
*APPLICATION SELECT*
1: DIAGNOSIS
2: CUSTOMIZE
3: ECU REPROGRAM
D
SELECT DATA
INJ VOL
A/F CONTROL
FUEL PMP SP CTL
A/C CUT SIG
CAN CTRL VSV
TANK BYPASS VSV
EVAP VSV (ALONE)
FUEL PUMP/SPD
LINE PRESS UP
B
FUNCTION SELECT FOR
NORTH AMERICA
1: OBD/MOBD
2: ENHANCED OBD
3: CARB OBD II
4: BREAK–OUT BOX
5: NVH
6: AUTOPROBE
7: 02 RPM CHECK
8: SNAPSHOT REVIEW
9: SETUP
0: GAS ANALYSIS
E
SELECT DATA
ALL
USER DATA
PRESS [ENTER]
C
DIAGNOSTIC MENU
ENGINE
1: DATA LIST
2: DTC INFO
3: ACTIVE TEST
4: SNAPSHOT
5: SYSTEM CHECK
6: RESET MEMORY
7: MONITOR STATUS
8: CHECK MODE
F
INJECTOR
0.0ms
IGN ADVANCE
5.0deg
CALC LOAD
0%
MAF
0gm/s
ENGINE SPD
0rpm
COOLANT TEMP 77.0tF
INTAKE AIR
87.8tF
THROTTLE POS 16%
CTP SW
ON
VEHICLE SPD
0MPH
02S B1 S1
0.00V
TANK BYPASS VSV "OFF
G
INJECTOR
0.0ms
IGN ADVANCE
5.0deg
CALC LOAD
0%
MAF
0gm/s
ENGINE SPD
0rpm
COOLANT TEMP 77.0tF
INTAKE AIR
87.8tF
THROTTLE POS 16%
CTP SW
ON
VEHICLE SPD
0MPH
02S B1 S1
0.00V
TANK BYPASS VSV "ON
NOTE:
Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV is listed as TANK BYPASS VSV on the Diagnostic Tester.
Page 2 of 5
M.I.L. “ON” P0440, P0441 & P0446 – EG013-02
Inspection &
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
July 12, 2002
2. Locate Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV as shown in Figure 2 (or see SFI section of 1998
or 1999 Camry or Solara Repair Manual).
Figure 2: Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV Components
Vapor Pressure Sensor
VSV Connector
Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV
Charcoal Canister
3. Using the Diagnostic Tester ACTIVE TEST, switch the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV
(TANK BYPASS VSV) to ON using the arrow keys.
4. Does the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV make a “click” noise when switched to ON?
YES " Go to “Test VSV for Vacuum Leaks” (page 4 and 5 of this TSB).
NO
" Go to Step 5.
5. Is the wiring harness connector properly connected to the Vapor Pressure Sensor
VSV?
YES " Go to Step 6.
NO
" Fix the connector, then return to Step 3.
6. Disconnect the wiring harness connector for the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV.
7. Using a DVOM test at Pin 1 to a known good ground. (Red wire on Solara, black and
yellow wire on Camry).
Is battery voltage (B+) present at Pin 1 of the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV connector
when the TANK BYPASS VSV ACTIVE TEST is switched to ON?
YES " Go to Step 8.
NO
" Perform diagnosis of power circuit.
Page 3 of 5
M.I.L. “ON” P0440, P0441 & P0446 – EG013-02
Inspection &
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
July 12, 2002
8. Using a DVOM test at Pin 2 to a known good ground. The ECM provides ground
when the VSV is switched ON. (White and red wire on Solara, violet wire on Camry).
Is there continuity to ground at Pin 2 of the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV connector
when the TANK BYPASS VSV ACTIVE TEST is switched to ON?
YES " Replace the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV.
NO
" Perform diagnosis of ground circuit.
Test VSV for Vacuum Leaks
1. Locate the vacuum hose going from charcoal canister to Port F of the Vapor Pressure
Sensor VSV (see Figure 3).
Figure 3
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Hose
Bracket
PORT F
Vacuum Hose
Vacuum Hose
Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV
VSV Connector
Charcoal Canister
2. Remove vacuum hose from Port F of the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV and connect a
hand–held vacuum pump to Port F using a short length of vacuum hose.
3. Apply at least 10 mm Hg vacuum to the VSV.
Is a vacuum held for at least 1 minute?
YES " Go to Step 4.
NO " Replace the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV.
4. Disconnect the hand–held vacuum pump and reconnect the vacuum hose from the
canister to the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV.
Page 4 of 5
M.I.L. “ON” P0440, P0441 & P0446 – EG013-02
Inspection &
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
July 12, 2002
5. Locate the vacuum hose going from charcoal canister to Port P of the Vapor Pressure
Sensor VSV (see Figure 4).
Figure 4
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Vacuum Hose
HOSE TO
REMOVE
Bracket
Vacuum Hose
Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV
Vacuum Hose
PORT P
VSV Connector
Charcoal Canister
6. Remove the vacuum hose from Port P of the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV and
connect a hand–held vacuum pump to Port P using a short length of vacuum hose.
7. Apply at least 10 mm Hg vacuum to the VSV.
Is a vacuum held for at least 1 minute?
YES " Go to Step 8.
NO " Replace the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV.
8. Disconnect the hand–held vacuum pump and reconnect the vacuum hose from the
canister to the Vapor Pressure Sensor VSV.
9. Continue diagnosis of the EVAP system.
Reference TSB EG005–01, “EVAP System Operation Information.”
Page 5 of 5
SINGLE CYLINDER MISFIRES
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’99 Avalon, Camry, Sienna & Solara
December 17, 1999
Introduction
Some 1999 Avalon, Camry (1MZ–FE), Sienna & Solara (1MZ–FE) vehicles may exhibit a
rough idle, and or a M.I.L. “ON” condition, in which a single cylinder misfire code, or
codes are present. Changes have been made in the fuel injector production process to
correct this condition.
Applicable
Vehicles
S 1999 TMMK produced Avalon, Camry (1MZ–FE), Sienna & TMMC produced Solara
(1MZ–FE) vehicles built between the VIN numbers listed below.
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
MODEL
STARTING VIN
ENDING VIN
Avalon
4T1BF1#B * XU298504
4T1BF1#B*XU319557
Camry
4T1BF2#K * XU076403
4T1BF2#K*XU081214
Camry (cont.)
4T1BF2#K * XU930024
4T1BF2#K*XU931330
Sienna
4T3ZF1#C * XU090887
4T3ZF1#C*XU122589
Solara (U.S.)
2T1CF2#P * XC111083
2T1CF2#P*XC757508
Solara (Canada)
2T1CF2#P * XC744113
2T1CF2#P*XC162681
APPLICABLE PARTS
QUANTITY
PART NAME
23209–0A010
6
Fuel Injector
OP CODE
VWC
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
895221
N
R & R Fuel Injector Assembly – All
1.8
23209–0A010
T1
T2
02 56
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Federal Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the
states of California, Massachusetts, and Vermont due to state emission warranty
legislation.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
NOTE:
Be sure to enter the DTC No. in the Condition/Cause/Remedy section, if a DTC Code
appeared.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ENGINE
EG013–99
Title:
SINGLE CYLINDER MISFIRE – EG013–99
Repair
Procedure
1. Remove all six fuel injectors for
verification of production information.
Affected injectors will be labeled with
a vendor part number of
“23250–0A010” and have a
production date code number of “828“
or lower (see illustration for number
locations).
2. After determining that one or more of
the injectors are affected, replace all
six injectors with the above applicable
part number.
3. Clear the DTC, if present, and verify
that the vehicle now operates as
designed.
Page 2 of 2
December 17, 1999
Production
Date
Part Number
Technical Service
BULLETIN
M.I.L. ON" DTC P1133
Models:
’97–’99 Camry and ’99 Solara: 5S–FE CA Spec.
October 1, 1999
Introduction
Under certain driving conditions, some 5S–FE equipped 1997–1999 Camry and 1999
Solara California emission specification vehicles may exhibit a M.I.L. “ON” DTC P1133.
An improved Air Fuel Ratio Sensor has been developed to correct this condition.
S 1997 – 1999 Camry & 1999 Solara (5S–FE) with California emission
specification.
Applicable
Vehicles
Production
Change
Information
MODEL YEAR
ORIGIN
ENGINE
STARTING VIN
JPN
JT2BG2#K*X0363615
4T1BG2#K*XU603913
1999 Camry
NAP
(5S–FE)
4T1BG2#K*XU918675
2000 Solara
*
*
Parts
Information
Repair
Procedure
––
# May be a 2 or an 8.
* May be any number from 0 to 9 or an X.
PREVIOUS PART NUMER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
89467–33010
89467–33011
Sensor, Air Fuel
S Should a M.I.L. “ON” condition with DTC P1133 be encountered, perform diagnostic
procedures as described in the Repair Manual.
S If the problem source cannot be identified after checking all affected areas according
to the Repair Manual, the cause may be an Air/Fuel Ratio Sensor malfunction. In this
case, replace the Air/Fuel Ratio Sensor with the updated part.
S If the Exhaust Manifold threads are damaged by removal of the sensor, they can be
repaired by the proper use of a M18 x 1.5 tap.
Warranty
Information
OPCODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
EL9006
Sensor, Air Fuel Ratio
0.3
89467–33010
99
99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, which ever occurs first, in the
states of California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
NOTE:
Please enter the DTC in the condition/Cause/Remedy section when applying for
warranty reimbursement.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
ENGINE
EG009–99
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
CIGARETTE LIGHTER SERVICE
Models:
All Models
Apirl 10, 1998
Introduction
Service
Procedure
When receiving customer complaints to repair the lighter or lighter socket, please
carefully investigate the cause of the failure to prevent further occurrences. If the
customer uses the wrong size lighter element or power accessory plug, damage may
occur to the lighter socket. When applicable, instruct the customer to replace the lighter
element with original equipment components or to use an appropriate sized accessory
plug. Dimensional information included within this document will instruct you on
component specifications.
1. Determine if the lighter is original equipment by using the specifications shown.
a. If the vehicle has a non–genuine lighter element, it has the possibility to cause
a short circuit between the lighter element and the lighter socket, which can
result in an open fuse.
b. A non–genuine lighter element may cause a rattle or bend the socket bimetal
contacts.
c. If a non–genuine lighter element is being used, advise the customer to use an
original equipment element.
DRAWING WITH DIMESIONS
Knob
8.4 mm (0.33”)
Genuine
22.5 (0.88”)
FEATURES
Bimetal
17.7–17.8 mm
(0.697–0.7”)
TYPE
Ash
No Problem to use.
Plate
Heater Element
Heater Head
Guard
20.7 mm
(0.81”)
13 mm (0.51”)
Non–Genuine
25.5 mm (1.0”)
20.8 mm
(0.82”)
11 mm (0.43”)
24 mm (0.94”)
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Too long an ash guard will
contact bimetal (positive
circuit) plate and cause fuse
to melt.
Excessive free play on the
heater head which allows
contact between heater
element, socket body and
bimetal plate, will cause fuse
to melt.
Page 1 of 2
ELECTRICAL
EL002–98
Title:
CIGARETTE LIGHTER SERVICE – EL002-98
b. Using a power plug larger
than the given dimensions
may damage the lighter
socket.
< 20.5 mm
(0.81”)
> 15 mm
(0.59”)
25 – 30 mm
(0.79 – 1.18”)
> 2 Terminals
< 20.5 mm
(0.81”)
a. The attached specifications in
the drawing provide the
maximum recommended size
of accessory plug. If the
customer is using an
accessory plug larger than
recommended, please advise
the customer to use a plug of
appropriate size.
Recommended Accessory Plug Shape
<13 mm
(0.51”)
2. If the lighter element is original
equipment and the lighter socket is
bent or pulled out of the dash, please
ask the customer about the accessory
plug being used in the lighter socket.
13 mm
(0.51”)
Service
Procedure
(Continued)
April 10, 1998
> 8.5 mm
(0.33”)
25 – 30 mm
(0.79 – 1.18”)
c. If the vehicle has a power
point socket, advise the
customer to use this socket
instead of the lighter socket.
Affected
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Page 2 of 2
S All models, all model years
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
SPEEDOMETER/TACHOMETER
NEEDLE MOVEMENT
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’99 – ’00 Camry, Corolla, Sienna, & Solara
& ’00 Avalon
February 11, 2000
December 13, 2002
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB was revised on December 13, 2002.
The previous TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
Some vehicles may experience a slight, intermittent resistance to movement of the
speedometer or tachometer needle near zero during the first few miles of travel. The
condition can be corrected by following the repair method outlined below.
NOTE:
This repair does not apply to speedometers or tachometers which are permanently
inoperative.
Applicable
Vehicles
S 1999 – 2000 model year Camry, Corolla, Sienna, & Solara,
and 2000 model year Avalon between the following VINs:
MODEL
STARTING VIN
ENDING VIN
Avalon
4T1BF28B * YU001171
4T1BF28B * YU030913
4T1BG2 * K * XU424095
4T1BG2 * K * YU657647
4T1BG2 * K * XU869714
4T1BG2 * K * YU957337
4T1BF2 * K * XU077249
4T1BF2 * K * YU098224
4T1BF2 * K * XU930237
4T1BF2 * K * YU940492
1NXBR1 * E * XZ171600
1NXBR1 * E * XC171600
1NXBR1 * E * YZ359500
1NXBR1 * E * YC359500
2T1BR1 * E * XC120816
2T1BR1 * E * YC291439
Sienna
4T3 * F1 * C * XU096570
4T3 * F1 * CZ * XU096570
4T3 * F1 * C * YU236332
4T3 * F1 * CZ * YU236332
Solara
2T1 * * 2 * P * XC122747
2T1 * * 2 * P * YC291165
Camry
Corolla
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
MODEL
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
830011
Avalon, Camry,
Corolla, Sienna,
& Solara
T1
R & R Speedometer Assembly
0.4
83220–XXXXX
T2
73 83
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ELECTRICAL
EL003–00
Title:
SPEEDOMETER/TACHOMETER NEEDLE MOVEMENT – EL003-02
Parts
Information
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
Repair
Procedure
Same
Tachometer
TOOLS & MATERIALS
QUANTITY
Double Sided Cotton Swab
1
Distilled Water
1 oz.
1. Remove the combination meter
assembly per repair manual
instructions.
2. Remove the window plate from the
instrument cluster.
3. Clean the entire surface of the needle
and needle stopper as illustrated.
Using one end of a double sided
cotton swab, clean the contact point
between the pointer and the stopper
pin on the speedometer and
tachometer with distilled water.
S Use only a new, clean cotton
swab.
S Use only distilled water.
S Use a new swab each time a part
is cleaned (one per speedometer,
one per tachometer).
NOTE:
S After cleaning, do not touch the
pointer needle or stopper pin.
S Do not blow dry the pointer or
stopper pin.
4. Use the opposite (dry) end of the
cotton swab to dry the previously
cleaned area.
5. Reassemble parts and assemble to
vehicle.
6. Confirm proper working condition of
speedometer and tachometer.
S Confirm no foreign material
entered the cluster while the
window plate was removed.
Page 2 of 2
PART NAME
Speedometer
83220 XXXXX
83220-XXXXX
Required
Tools &
Material
Revised: December 13, 2002 February 11, 2000
Technical Service
BULLETIN
October 8, 1999
ENGINE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
PRECAUTIONS
Models:
All Models
REVISION NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates EL001–98 dated January 23, 1998.
Introduction
This bulletin applies to 1998 and newer Toyota vehicles. When using an immobilizer key
containing a transponder chip, observe the following precautions while starting the engine.
1. The key ring should not rest on or be
pressed against the key grip.
2. Do not place any other transponder
devices on the same key ring. Such
devices would include transponder
equipped units used for charging fuel.
3. Do not place any other immobilizer
keys on the same key ring with the
key used to start the vehicle.
4. If the above precautions are not
observed and an engine starting or
running problem occurs, remove all
items which may interfere with the
ignition key transponder signal. Turn
off the engine and then restart.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S All Toyota models equipped with an engine immobilizer system.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
ELECTRICAL
EL006–99
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
April 14, 2000
Introduction
HEATER CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSTRUCTIONS
Models:
’97 – ’99 Camry
The attached instructions have been developed to supplement the Repair Manual to
assure corrrect cable routing of the heater control assembly during a service repair.
PUBLICATION
NUMBER
1997 Camry Repair Manual, Vol. 2
RM503U2
1998 Camry Repair Manual, Vol. 2
RM589U2
1999 Camry Repair Manual, Vol. 2
RM654U2
NOTE:
For maximum heater performance the coolant ratio should be 50 to 60 percent.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 1997 – 1999 model year Camry
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
ELECTRICAL
EL007–00
Title:
POOR HEATER PERFORMANCE – EL007–00
Installation
Procedure
April 14, 2000
A. Pull out the inner cable of the
REC/FRE cable until the link of the
A/C unit contacts the link stopper.
View A
View A
Left Side
Top
Rear
Link
Should make
contact here.
Link Stopper
B. Set the air intake selector of the
heater control unit all the way to the
“FRESH” position.
C. Attach the REC/FRE cable to the
heater control unit lever pin and clamp
the outer cable to the secure clamp.
NOTE:
Clamp the cable while pushing the
outer cable to the A/C unit assembly
side.
Page 2 of 4
Lever
POOR HEATER PERFORMANCE – EL007–00
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 14, 2000
D. Install the heater control panel to the
instrument panel with 4 screws.
NOTE:
Make sure air mix cable is routed
outside of the brace.
REC/FRE Cable
(from A/C Unit)
Instrument Panel
Step (A)
Step (C)
Step (D)
Air Mix Cable
Top
Front Side
Right Side
Screw (4)
Page 3 of 4
POOR HEATER PERFORMANCE – EL007–00
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
April 14, 2000
E. Set the temperature selector of the
heater control unit to the “MAX.
COOL” position.
MAX.
COOL
F. Connect the air mix cable connector
to the air mix link pin on the left side
of the A/C unit and clamp the outer
cable to the secure clamp.
NOTE:
S It is unnecessary to push or pull the
outer cable.
S Do not bend the cable when setting
the cable.
S Do not move the air mix knob until
you are finished clamping the outer
cable.
Inspection
Procedure
1. Rotary Knob For Temperature
Control
Operate the temperature control
rotary knob after setting the cables,
check that there is a “thump” at the
end of the travel, and no reversing
force at “MAX. COOL” or “MAX. HOT”
position.
2. Air Inlet Lever
Operate air inlet lever after setting the
cable and check that there is a “click”
at the end of the travel and no
reversing force at “RECIRCULATE”
and “FRESH” positions.
3. Blower Switch, Air Flow Mode
Switch & A/C Switch
Operate each switch and make sure
they are operating correctly.
Page 4 of 4
Air
Mix
Link
Technical Service
BULLETIN
December 4, 1998
Introduction
PROGRAMMING OEM WIRELESS
DOOR LOCK REMOTE TRANSMITTERS
Models:
’97 – ’99 Camry
This bulletin describes procedures used to program the three button remote transmitter to
vehicles that are equipped with Wireless Door Lock Control. The following information
applies only to the Factory Wireless Door Lock Control, not dealer or port installed
options that also utilize remotes, such as VIP Keyless Entry/RS3000 or any aftermarket
system.
Verification of Factory Wireless Door Lock Control can easily be performed by identifying
the TDS status monitor, functioning remote, or model grade.
Transmitter Identification
S
The Remote Transmitter has LOCK,
UNLOCK, and PANIC features.
TDS Status Montior Indentification
S
The TDS Status Monitor is located in
the Tachometer.
NOTE:
When a new remote is programmed, all previous codes are erased. Because of this,
all remotes should be entered during the same programming session, otherwise a
remote may no longer be registered and operate the vehicle.
For Customer Satisfaction, request that any existing remote be furnished when
programming a new or replacement unit.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
S 1997 – 1999 Camrys:
1997 – 1998 All XLE (standard equipment) and some LE (optional)
1999 All XLE only
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
ELECTRICAL
EL008–98
Title:
PROGRAMMING OEM WIRELESS DOOR LOCK REMOTE TRANSMITTERS – EL008–98
Programing
Procedure
December 4, 1998
The PRG (Program) circuit of the
Wireless Door Lock ECU is grounded to
perform programming. This can be
accomplished at a satellite location, the
Mirror Control Switch (see illustration).
NOTE:
Up to two remotes can be programmed
to operate each vehicle.
Mirror Control Switch
2. Using a suitable jumper wire, connect
terminal number 2, PRG (violet wire)
to terminal number 10, GND
(white/black) of the 10 cavity mirror
control switch connector (illustrated).
The vehicle confirms programming
mode by requesting the power door
locks to lock.
Wireless
Door Lock
E.C.U.
Violet
PRG
White–Black
1. With the key OUT of the ignition
switch, locate and disconnect the
Mirror Control Switch from the vehicle
harness.
Jumper Wire
GND
Wire Harness
3. Depress, then release, any button on
the remote. The vehicle confirms
registration by requesting the power
door locks to lock once again.
4. To program an additional remote,
repeat step 3.
Program (PRG)
5. Disconnect the jumper wire to exit
programming mode.
Wire Harness
Mirror Control Switch Connector
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
December 20, 2002
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER &
PROGRAMMING GUIDE
Models:
All Applicable
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
S February 28, 2003: In Wireless Transmitter Identification section (pages 5 and 6),
Figures 5, 9, 10, 12, and 13 updated to include 2003 model year; Figure 11 updated
to include 1999 and 2003 model year.
S January 17, 2003: 2003 model year added to Solara in the Application Chart on
page 3.
S The information contained in this TSB supercedes TSB EL010–01, dated October 26,
2001. The previous TSB, EL010–01, should be discarded.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
System
Identification
Difficulties during Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming can arise due to
confusion between Toyota Factory Wireless systems and Toyota Port/Dealer installed
systems. This bulletin will assist in identifying the system/correct remote transmitters for
each vehicle, and provide the location of the most accurate programming procedure for
each system.
S All applicable Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
The following table contains all of the necessary information to correctly identify the type
of system installed, and where to go to get programming procedures for each vehicle.
NOTE:
Should a vehicle having both VIP and Factory systems available (as identified in the
following table) be brought in without any remotes (or one non–working remote), use
the following tips to help determine which type of wireless system (O.E. or PIO/DIO)
the vehicle has.
S Look at the Trim Level of the vehicle. Higher–grade vehicles will tend to have O.E.
systems, while entry–grade vehicles will tend to have VIP. For example, the 2001
Camry XLE has Factory RKE, but the LE and CE grades have VIP.
S Look for a “Status Monitor” with a glass breakage sensor and an LED externally
installed into the dashboard or on the center console. Most VIP systems will have
this.
S Locate the ECU (refer to the applicable vehicle VIP Manual installation instructions
for location). Once located, refer to the part label.
S Attempt to perform the factory wireless programming procedure to get a response
from the vehicle. Select the “confirmation mode” and see if any “Lock/Unlock”
response is received, if so, the vehicle has a factory system.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 6
ELECTRICAL
EL008-02
Title:
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL008-02 Revised
Application
Chart
APPLICATION
VEHICLE
A l
Avalon
YEAR
SYSTEM/REMOTE
PROGRAMMING
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner’s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 1999
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2000 – 2001
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
2002 – 2003
N/A
N/A
1990 – 1994
1995
1996
Camry
y
DEALER/PORT INSTALLED
1997
TVSS / Fig. 1
*1
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
RS3000 / Fig.
Fig 3
1998 – 1999
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2000 – 2001
RS3200 /
Fig. 5 or 6 *7
2002 – 2003
1990 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1
*1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
TSB – AX005–99
2000 VIP Manual *6
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 1999
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2000 – 2003
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
1990 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 2002
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2003
RS3200 / Fig. 5
Cressida
1991 – 1992
ECHO
4Runner
Land Cruiser
Fig.
g 9 *2
RM 02 V2, BE–99
TSB – EL004–01
N/A
N/A
Fig 7
Fig.
TSB – EL008–98
EL008 98
Fig. 11
RM 01 V2, BE–86
*2
TSB – EL004–01
Fig. 9
N/A
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
N/A
N/A
2000 VIP Manual *6
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
TDSE / Fig. 1 *1
TVSS Owner’s
Guide
N/A
N/A
2000 – 2003
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
1990 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
N/A
N/A
1998
RS3000 / Fig.
Fig 4
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
TSB – AX005–99
RM 02 V2,
V2 BE–98
BE 98
2000 – 2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
2003
N/A
N/A
2001 – 2003
N/A
N/A
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
1991 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
N/A
N/A
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
TSB – AX005–99
N/A
N/A
Fig. 13
RM 02 V1,
DI–624
Fig.
g 10 *5
RM 03, 73–16
1998 – 2002
2003
Page 2 of 6
TSB – EL003
EL003–99
99
N/A
1999
Highlander
Fig. 8
PROGRAMMING
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
Corolla
FACTORY INSTALLED
FACTORY
REMOTE
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
1995
Celica
December 20, 2002
RM 03 V2, BE–93
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL008-02 Revised
Application
Chart
(Continued)
APPLICATION
DEALER/PORT INSTALLED
December 20, 2002
FACTORY INSTALLED
VEHICLE
YEAR
SYSTEM/REMOTE
PROGRAMMING
FACTORY
REMOTE
Matrix
2003
N/A
N/A
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1991 – 1994
MR2
1995
2001 – 2003
1992 – 1994
Paseo
Previa
Prius
RAV4
Sequoia
TDSE / Fig. 1
*1
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
RS3200
*3
/ Fig.5
TVSS / Fig. 1
*1
2003 VIP Manual
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1991 – 1994
TDSE / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
TSB – AX005–99
2001 – 2003
N/A
N/A
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 2000
RS3000 / Fig. 4
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
N/A
N/A
2001 – 2003
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
2001 – 2003
N/A
N/A
Fig. 10 *5
RM 03 V2,
BE–105
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
1998
1999
Sienna
Solara
S pra
Supra
T100
Tacoma
PROGRAMMING
2000
Fig. 7
RS3000 / Fig.
Fig 4
RS3000 / Fig.4
TSB – AX005–99
*4
TSB – EL009–98
Fig. 11 /
Fig. 12
2001 – 2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
2003
N/A
N/A
1999 – 2001
RS3000 / Fig. 4
TSB – AX005–99
Fig. 11
2002–2003
N/A
N/A
Fig. 9 *2
1991 – 1992
TDSE / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TDSE / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1993 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 2001
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
2003
RS3200*3 / Fig. 5
2003 VIP Manual *6
RM 02 V2, BE–87
RM 03 V2, BE–91
RM 02 V2
V2, BE
BE–87
87
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
TSB – AX005–99
Page 3 of 6
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL008-02 Revised
Application
Chart
(Continued)
APPLICATION
VEHICLE
Tercel
Tr ck
Truck
T ndra
Tundra
Page 4 of 6
DEALER/PORT INSTALLED
YEAR
SYSTEM/REMOTE
PROGRAMMING
1991 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1990 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
2000 – 2001
RS3000 / Fig. 4
TSB – AX005–99
2002 – 2003
RS3200*3 / Fig. 5
2003 VIP Manual
December 20, 2002
FACTORY INSTALLED
FACTORY
REMOTE
PROGRAMMING
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
*1
Original style TVSS/TDSE system remotes are no longer available as replacement parts. Black RS3000
remotes (Figure 3) can be used with these systems.
*2
While the outward appearances are the same, there are 3 different remotes of this style (not interchangeable).
Check the FCC ID Number on the back of the remote to verify correct application:
S Avalon 1998 – 1999 FCC ID: HYQ1512Y / 2000 – 2003 FCC ID: HYQ12BAN
S Camry/Solara 2002 – 2003 FCC ID: GQ43VT14T
*3
This is a variant of the RS3200 TDS system, which does not include the security functions. The VIP manual
outlines programming procedures used on these vehicles.
*4
RS3200 was launched prior to the 2001 MY Change Over. Please refer to the 2000 VIP Manual if necessary.
*5
While the outward appearances are the same, there are 2 different remotes of this style (not interchangeable).
Check the FCC ID Number on the back of the remote to verify correct application:
S 1999 – 2002 4Runner – FCC ID: HYQ1512Y
S Sequoia / 2003 4Runner – FCC ID: HYQ12BAN
*6
RS3200 programming procedures were sent as a supplement to the 2000 VIP Manual. This information can
now be found on the TIS system.
*7
The RS3200 system was only available on early production vehicles in the 2003 model year.
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL008-02 Revised
Wireless
Transmitter
Identification
December 20, 2002
DEALER or PORT INSTALLED SYSTEMS
Figure 1.
Figure 2.
Figure 3.
TVSS/TDSE
1990 – 1994
TVSS/TDSE
1995
RS3000 (BLACK)
1996 – 1997
Figure 4.
Figure 5.
Figure 6.
RS3000 (GRAY)
1998 – 2002
RS3200*
2000 – 2003
RS3200*
2000 – 2002
* Panic Button on Back Side
Page 5 of 6
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL008-02 Revised
Wireless
Transmitter
Identification
(Continued)
FACTORY INSTALLED or “ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT” SYSTEMS
Figure 7.
Figure 8.
O.E. 3 Button
1997 – 1999
O.E. 3 Button
1995 – 1997
Figure 9.
Figure 10.
Figure 11.
O.E. 4 Button*
1998 – 2003
O.E. 4 Button*
1999 – 2003
O.E. 3 Button*
1999 – 2003
* Panic Button on Back Side
Page 6 of 6
December 20, 2002
Figure 12.
Figure 13.
O.E. 4 Button*
1999 – 2003
O.E. In–Key
1998 – 2003
OBSOLETE
PLEASE SEE EL008–02
October 26, 2001
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
System
Identification
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER &
PROGRAMMING GUIDE
Models:
All Applicable
Difficulties during Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming can arise due to
confusion between Toyota Factory Wireless systems and Toyota Port/Dealer installed
systems. This bulletin will assist in identifying the system/correct remote transmitters for
each vehicle, and provide the location of the most accurate programming procedure for
each system.
S All applicable Toyota vehicles.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
The following table contains all of the necessary information to correctly identify the type
of system installed, and where to go to get programming procedures for each vehicle.
NOTE:
Should a vehicle having both VIP and Factory systems available (as identified in the
following table) be brought in without any remotes (or one non–working remote), use
the following tips to help determine which type of wireless system (O.E. or PIO/DIO)
the vehicle has.
S Look at the Trim Level of the vehicle. Higher–grade vehicles will tend to have O.E.
systems, while entry–grade vehicles will tend to have VIP. For example, the 2001
Camry XLE has Factory RKE, but the LE and CE grades have VIP.
S Look for a “Status Monitor” with a glass breakage sensor and an LED externally
installed into the dashboard or on the center console. Most VIP systems will have
this.
S Locate the ECU (refer to the applicable vehicle VIP Manual installation instructions
for location). Once located, refer to the part label.
S Attempt to perform the factory wireless programming procedure to get a response
from the vehicle. Select the “confirmation mode” and see if any “Lock/Unlock”
response is received, if so, the vehicle has a factory system.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 5
ELECTRICAL
Technical Service
BULLETIN
EL010-01
Title:
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL010-01
Application
Chart
APPLICATION
VEHICLE
A l
Avalon
FACTORY INSTALLED
FACTORY
REMOTE
SYSTEM/REMOTE
PROGRAMMING
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner’s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 1999
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2000 – 2001
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
2002
N/A
N/A
1990 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1997
RS3000 / Fig.
Fig 3
1998 – 1999
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2000 – 2001
RS3200 / Fig. 5
or 6
2002
1990 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1
*1
Fig. 8
TSB – AX005–99
2000 VIP Manual *6
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 1999
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2000 – 2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
1990 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 2002
RS3000 / Fig. 4
Cressida
1991 – 1992
TDSE / Fig. 1 *1
ECHO
2000 – 2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
1990 – 1994
*1
4R nner
4Runner
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
1999
Highlander
MR2
RS3000 / Fig.
Fig 4
Fig.
g 9 *2
RM 02 V2,
V2 BE–99
BE 99
N/A
N/A
Fig 7
Fig.
TSB – EL008–98
EL008 98
Fig. 11
RM 01 V2, BE–86
Fig. 9
*2
RM 02 V2, 73–8
N/A
N/A
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
N/A
N/A
TVSS Owner’s
Guide
N/A
N/A
2000 VIP Manual *6
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
N/A
N/A
Fig 10 *5
Fig.
RM 02 V2,
V2 BE–98
BE 98
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
TSB – AX005–99
2000 – 2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
2001 – 2002
N/A
N/A
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
N/A
N/A
Fig. 13
RM 02 V1,
DI–624
N/A
N/A
1991 – 1994
Land Cruiser
TVSS / Fig. 1
TSB – EL003
EL003–99
99
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
Corolla
PROGRAMMING
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
1995
Celica
TVSS / Fig. 1
*1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
TSB – AX005–99
1998 – 2002
N/A
N/A
1991 – 1994
TDSE / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
2001 – 2002
Page 2 of 5
DEALER/PORT INSTALLED
YEAR
1996
Camry
y
October 26, 2001
RS3200
*3
/ Fig.5
2000 VIP Manual
*6
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL010-01
Application
Chart
(Continued)
APPLICATION
VEHICLE
Paseo
Previa
Prius
RAV4
Sequoia
Sienna
Solara
S pra
Supra
T100
Tacoma
Tercel
Tr ck
Truck
Tundra
October 26, 2001
DEALER/PORT INSTALLED
PROGRAMMING
FACTORY INSTALLED
FACTORY
REMOTE
PROGRAMMING
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
YEAR
SYSTEM/REMOTE
1992 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1991 – 1994
TDSE / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
TSB – AX005–99
2001 – 2002
N/A
N/A
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 2000
RS3000 / Fig. 4
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
N/A
N/A
2001 – 2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
Fig. 11
TSB – EL004–01
2001 – 2002
N/A
N/A
Fig. 10 *5
RM 02 V2,
BE–100
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1999
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2000
RS3000 / Fig.4 *4
2001 – 2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
1999 – 2001
RS3000 / Fig. 4
TSB – AX005–99
Fig. 11
2002
N/A
N/A
Fig. 9 *2
1991 – 1992
TDSE / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TDSE / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1993 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998 – 2001
RS3000 / Fig. 4
2002
RS3200 / Fig. 5
2000 VIP Manual *6
1991 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
1996 – 1997
RS3000 / Fig. 3
1998
RS3000 / Fig. 4
1990 – 1994
TVSS / Fig. 1 *1
1995
TVSS / Fig. 2 *1
2000 – 2002
RS3000 / Fig. 4
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
Fig. 7
TSB – AX005–99
TSB – EL009–98
Fig. 11 /
Fi
Fig 12
Fig.
RM 02 V2, BE–87
RM 02 V2
V2, BE
BE–87
87
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
N/A
N/A
TSB – AX005–99
N/A
N/A
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
TVSS Owner
Owner’s
s
Guide
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
TSB – AX005–99
TSB – AX005–99
AX005 99
Page 3 of 5
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL010-01
Application
Chart
(Continued)
*1
Original style TVSS/TDSE system remotes are no longer available as replacement parts. Black RS3000
remotes (Figure 3) can be used with these systems.
*2
While the outward appearances are the same, there are 3 different remotes of this style (not
interchangeable). Check the FCC ID Number on the back of the remote to verify correct application:
S Avalon 1998 – 1999 FCC ID: HYQ1512Y / 2000 – 2002 FCC ID: HYQ12BAN
S Camry/Solara 2002 FCC ID: GQ43VT14T
*3
The MR2 Spyder uses a variant of the RS3200 TDS system, which does not include the security functions.
RS3200 programming procedures should be used for this vehicle.
*4
RS3200 was launched prior to the 2001 MY Change Over. Please refer to the 2000 VIP Manual if
necessary.
*5
The Sequoia and 4Runner remotes look the same but have different FCC ID Numbers (not interchangeable):
S 4Runner – FCC ID: HYQ1512Y
S Sequoia – FCC ID: HYQ12BAN
*6
RS 3200 programming procedures were sent as a supplement to the 2000 VIP Manual. If you require an
additional copy of this information, it can be ordered from the Material Distribution Center (MDC) through
your parts department: P/N 00107–00282–04.
Wireless
Transmitter
Identification
Page 4 of 5
October 26, 2001
DEALER or PORT INSTALLED SYSTEMS
Figure 1.
Figure 2.
Figure 3.
TVSS/TDSE
1990 – 1994
TVSS/TDSE
1995
RS3000 (BLACK)
1996 – 1997
Figure 4.
Figure 5.
Figure 6.
RS3000 (GRAY)
1998 – 2002
RS3200
2000 – 2002
RS3200
2000 – 2002
WIRELESS TRANSMITTER & PROGRAMMING GUIDE – EL010-01
Wireless
Transmitter
Identification
(Continued)
October 26, 2001
FACTORY INSTALLED or “ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT” SYSTEMS
Figure 7.
Figure 8.
O.E. 3 Button
1997 – 1999
O.E. 3 Button
1995 – 1997
Figure 9.
Figure 10.
Figure 11.
O.E. 4 Button*
2000 – 2002
O.E. 4 Button*
1999 – 2002
O.E. 3 Button*
2000 – 2002
Figure 12.
Figure 13.
O.E. 4 Button*
1999 – 2002
O.E. In–Key
1998 – 2002
* Panic Button on Back Side
Page 5 of 5
Technical Service
BULLETIN
October 6, 2000
Introduction
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT DISABLING
PROCEDURE
Models:
All Models
Some customers may request to have the Daytime Running Lights (DRL) on their Toyota
vehicle disabled. These customers may live or work in military bases or in communities
that have light–sensitive gates or guardhouses. This bulletin provides instructions for
disabling the feature on the Toyota vehicles listed below. If the Daytime Running Lights
(DRL) have been previously disabled, the information in this bulletin can be used to
enable the feature at the request of the customer.
IMPORTANT:
Please be sure the customer is informed that when the Daytime Running Lights (DRL)
are being disabled, although it is not required by the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards for safety compliance, it has been listed as a safety feature in advertising
brochures. In addition, on models equipped with the Twilight Sentinel feature, the
headlights will be defaulted to a manual system and will no longer function
automatically.
S All Models equipped with Daytime Running Lights (DRL) (see chart below).
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Information
TOOLS & MATERIALS
QUANTITY
Wire Harness Repair Kit
1
NOTE:
After referencing the chart, proceed to the repair procedure on the following pages.
Reference
Chart
MODEL
Avalon
Camry S/D*
Camry Solara*
Celica*
Corolla*
ECHO
4Runner
Land Cruiser
MR2 Spyder
RAV4
Sienna
Tacoma
Tundra
*
Warranty
Information
MODEL YEAR
ECU
CONNECTOR
PIN#
EWD PG#
1999
2000
1999
2000
1999/2000
2000
1999/2000
2000
2000
1999/2000
2000
1999/2000
1999/2000
2000
2000
DRL Main Relay
Body ECU
D4
B5
DRL Main Relay
D6
Body ECU
B6
D3
D2
1
6
23
10
23
17
23
12
D8
2
D2
D17
D4
D8
D7
12
110
99
102
96
102/96
75
84/72
67
99
90/88
69
72/70
83/81
115
95
DRL Main Relay
2
Vehicles equipped with Twilight Sentinel.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
ELECTRICAL
EL011–00
Title:
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT DISABLING PROCEDURE – EL011–00
Repair
Procedure
1. Disconnect the Battery.
2. Use the locking pick tool from the wire
harness repair kit and back out the
terminal from the appropriate
connector for the DRL Relay or Body
ECU. See the Reference Chart on
Page 1 of this bulletin for pin and
connector information.
October 6, 2000
DRL Relay or Body ECU
W/H
3. Insulate the removed terminal using
vinyl electrical tape.
Insulate
Terminal
4. Secure the wire and terminal to the
outside of the wire harness using vinyl
electrical tape.
Tape insulated
terminal to
outside of
wire harness.
NOTE:
For the 2000 MY Avalon, proceed to
Step 5. For all remaining models,
proceed to Step 6.
5. For 2000 model year Avalon:
A. Order a new terminal with lead that
is the same size and type as the
terminal previously removed from
the connector. (PN 82998–12690)
B. Securely attach a 45 cm/ 18 in wire
with an outside diameter of 2.0 mm
or larger to the tail of the new
terminal.
Page 2 of 3
P.N. 82998–12690
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT DISABLING PROCEDURE – EL011–00
Repair
Procedure
October 6, 2000
C. Securely attach an eyelet with a
hole size of 7 mm to the end of the
new wire.
D. Insert the new terminal with lead
into the Body ECU Connector B5,
previously vacated by the original
terminal.
E. Properly attach and route the new
wire to the exterior of the existing
wire harness in a manner that will
not allow it to become damaged or
come into contact with any other
circuits.
F. Securely attach the eyelet to the
existing ground point located in the
left kick panel area. (Ground Point
IF)
6. Check that the Daytime Running Light
(DRL) operation has been disabled.
7. Reassemble any interior panels that
were removed to gain access to
components, connectors, etc.
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
DOOR MIRROR WIND NOISE
Models:
’97 – ’99 Camry
March 31, 2000
TSB Update Notice:
The information contained in this TSB updates The information contained in this TSB
updates BO019–99 dated December 3, 1999. Revised text is red and underlined.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Wind/road noise heard around the door mirrors of some Japan produced Camry vehicles
may be caused by an improperly positioned mirror wire harness grommet and/or harness
connector.
S 1997 through 1999 Camry vehicles. (Japan produced only)
Production
Change
Information
Warranty
Information
PLANT
STARTING VIN
TMC
JT2BG22K * X0367325
JT2BG28K * X0367352
JT2BF22K * X0227381
JT2BF28K * X0227306
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
BD0009
Adjust the Wire Harness Grommet
and/or Connector
0.4
OPN
T1
T2
87940–XXXXX–XX (LH)
59 57
87910–XXXXX–XX (RH)
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Repair
Procedure
1. Carefully pry off the door speaker
cover and remove the nut using a 10
mm socket that secures the speaker
to the door.
2. Look through the door mirror harness
access hole and check the position of
the wire harness grommet and wire
harness connector – the harness
connector should be inside the
grommet and the grommet should be
fully seated in the mirror housing.
Connector
and Grommet
Speaker
Mirror Housing
Connector
Grommet
CORRECT POSITION
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
NVH
NV007–00
Title:
DOOR MIRROR WIND NOISE – NV007–00
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
March 31, 2000
Examples of improperly installed assemblies are shown below:
INCORRECT POSITION A
INCORRECT POSITION B
Mirror Housing
INCORRECT POSITION C
Mirror Housing
Mirror Housing
Grommet
Connector
Grommet
3. To reposition the grommet and/or
harness connector onto the mirror
housing:
S Remove the mirror housing (the
remaining 2 nuts) from the door
and carefully unclip the mirror
from the housing. This will allow
easier access and reinstallation of
the grommet and/or harness
connector.
S Reposition the grommet so it is
fully seated to the mirror housing.
Assure the harness connector is
inside the grommet.
NOTE:
Refer to the 1998 Camry Repair Manual
pages BO–23 through BO–26.
4. Reinstall the door mirror and speaker
assembly:
S Secure the mirror to the housing.
S Properly align and reinstall the
mirror assembly to the door.
Tighten the upper and forward
nuts. Torque: 5.5 NSm (56
KgfScm, 49 inSlb)
S Reinstall the door speaker (one
nut at the lower bracket) and
speaker cover onto the door as
shown in the illustration. Torque:
5.5 NSm (56 KgfScm, 49 inSlb)
S Assure the power mirror
adjustment and the door speaker
functions properly.
NOTE:
Do NOT mount the UPPER speaker
bracket behind the nut.
Page 2 of 2
Connector
Connector
Grommet
Outside Door
Mirror
Rear View
Mirror
Connector
Mirror Housing
Grommet
CORRECT POSITION
Outside Rear
View Mirror
Cover
Door Trim
5.5 (55, 49, ftSlbf)
NSm (kgfScm, ftSlbf)
INCORRECT
: Specified Torque
CORRECT
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 12, 1999
Introduction
1999 PAINT AND REFINISH FORMULA
CODES
Models:
All 1999 Models
Attached for your reference is a list of all 1999 OEM paint codes and refinish paint codes
for the following paint manufacturers:
BASF, DuPont, ICI Autocolor, PPG, Sherwin Williams, Sikkens,
Spies–Hecker, and Standox
NOTE:
The body color code is on the vehicle Certification Regulation Label, located on the
left front door “B” Pillar or door rear lower surface.
Please contact your local paint representative for the actual paint
mixing formulas or if you need help in color matching.
Affected
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
Paint Codes &
Color Names
S All 1999 Models.
OPCODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
ICI
SHERWIN
SPIES–
COLOR
CODE
COLOR NAME
BASF
DUPONT
040
Super White
TOY040
W8430
KK47
90288
35000
TOY040
17143
040
049
White Pearl
TOY049
N9033
L9018
TA99G
PC61B
90673
90674
40881
40882
TOY049
97746
049
051
Diamond White Pearl
TOY051
L9246
L9247
PF76B
TD86G
90822
90826
42872
42873
TOY051
98125
16329
051
056
Natural White
TOY056
F1858
BAB5
91452
52893
TOY056
15217
056
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
AUTOCOLOR
PPG
WILLIAMS
SIKKENS
HECKER
STANDOX
Page 1 of 5
PAINT
PA002–99
Title:
1999 PAINT AND REFINISH FORMULA CODES – PA002–99
Paint Codes &
Color Names
(Continued)
Page 2 of 5
March 12, 1999
ICI
SHERWIN
SPIES–
COLOR
CODE
COLOR NAME
BASF
DUPONT
181
Silver Metallic
TOY181
L9245
C523B
34878
44337
TOY181
98127
181
199
Alpine Silver Metallic
TOY199
L9990
5TX1B
4900
48976
TOY199
70706
199
1A0
Platinum Metallic
TOY1A0
N9923
6ED5B
4896
49700
TOY1A0
70809
1A0
1A2
Topaz Metallic
TOY1A2
F0016
6ED9B
4898
49701
TOY1A2
70855
1A2
1A3
Silver Metallic
TOY1A3
F0697
7DJ9B
35841
53001
TOY1A3
72319
1A3
1A5
Desert Dune Pearl
TOY1A5
F1458
8NH3B
36090
52139
TOY1A5
72759
1A5
1B1
Champagne Pearl
TOY1B1
F2186
FLT9B
5252
53074
TOY1B1
20699
1B1
1B2
Antique Sage Pearl
TOY1B2
F2201
HRE5B
5324
54757
TOY1B2
73622
1B2
1B9
Quiksilver FX
TOY1B9
F4996
LJC5B
5449
56738
TOY1B9
74332
1B9
1C0
Millennium Silver
TOY1C0
F4928
LCJ4B
36643
56793
TOY1C0
74500
1C0
1C3
River Rock Green Mica
TOY1C3
F4513
LVT2B
48703
57226
TOY1C3
74488
1C3
1C4
Silverstream Op
TOY1C4
F5137
NPD6B
5560
57927
TOY1C4
74771
1C4
1C7
Thunder Gray Metallic
TOY1C7
F5581
PEJ6B
5600
58581
TOY1C7
74806
1C7
1C8
Lunar Mist Metallic
TOY1C8
F8569
PEJ7B
5539
58582
TOY1C8
74807
1C8
202
Black
TOY202
FO220
0122
95100
57871
TOY202
72941
202
204
Black Metallic
TOY204
H8645
A237B
9624
35533
TOY204
96020
204
205
Satin Black Metallic
TOY205
L9024
B941B
9756
40888
TOY205
97765
205
3E5
Super Red
TOY3E5
W8431
KK41
72717
35001
TOY3E5
38236
3E5
3H7
Cardinal Red
TOY3H7
L9026
WJ91
73279
40890
TOY3H7
38805
3H7
3J8
Prussian Red Pearl
TOY3J8
W9463
PT73B
4596
46590
TOY3J8
99827
3J8
3K4
Sunfire Red Pearl
TOY3K4
W9546
PM54B
4511
46144
TOY3K4
99722
3K4
3L2
Renaissance Red
TOY3L2
L9992
5TX3B
4902
48978
TOY3L2
30491
3L2
3L5
Radiant Red
TOY3L5
F2688
GNK8
5287
54291
TOY3L5
33476
3L5
3M5
Sandrift Metallic
TOY3M5
F3531
LCP1B
5444
56742
TOY3M5
34261
3M5
3M6
Napa Burgundy Pearl
TOY3M6
F3747
LJC2B
5447
56739
TOY3M6
34262
3M6
3M8
Venetian Red Pearl
TOY3M8
F4929
LCJ5B
5561
56795
TOY3M8
34300
3M8
3M9
Baroque Red Metallic
TOY3M9
F4464
KWB9B
5421
56658
TOY3M9
34257
3M9
3N1
Cinnabar Pearl
TOY3N1
F4483
LPC9B
5435
56752
TOY3N1
34254
3N1
3N2
Mahogany Pearl
TOY3N2
F1744
LVT3B
28763
57227
TOY3N2
34317
3N2
3N5
Red Flame Metallic
TOY3N5
F5138
NPD7B
5563
57928
TOY3N5
34587
3N5
3N6
Vintage Red Pearl
TOY3N6
F8568
PEB8B
5525
58338
TOY3N6
34622
3N6
4J6
Sadona Sunset Metallic
TOY4J6
L9028
B945B
26601
40892
TOY4J6
97753
4J6
4M4
Sierra Beige Metallic
TOY4M4
H9879
4SS7B
4743
47606
TOY4M4
20157
4M4
AUTOCOLOR
PPG
WILLIAMS
SIKKENS
HECKER
STANDOX
1999 PAINT AND REFINISH FORMULA CODES – PA002–99
Paint Codes &
Color Names
(Continued)
March 12, 1999
ICI
SHERWIN
SPIES–
COLOR
CODE
COLOR NAME
BASF
DUPONT
4M7
Oyster Pearl
TOY4M7
K9968
5MK6B
27579
48841
TOY4M7
10655
4M7
4M9
Cashmere Beige
Metallic
TOY4M9
N9924
6ED6B
4903
49702
TOY4M9
20261
4M9
4N5
Vintage Rose Metallic
TOY4N5
F2716
HYV5B
5339
54862
TOY4N5
15817
4N5
4N7
Sable Pearl
TOY4N7
F3748
LJC3B
5448
56740
TOY4N7
22236
4N7
4P1
Antique Bronze Metallic
TOY4P1
F4465
KWC1B
5422
56659
TOY4P1
81642
4P1
4P3
Desert Bronze Metallic
LEX4P3
F7145
LVT4B
28764
57228
LEX4P3
22317
4P3
4P5
Autumn Blaze Metallic
TOY4P5
F5583
PEC1B
5526
58340
TOY4P5
34623
4P5
4P6
Autumn Red Mica
TOY4P6
F5139
NPD8B
5565
57929
TOY4P6
34588
4P6
578
Golden Sand Metallic
TOY578
F3749
LNX6B
5457
56741
TOY578
22189
578
6M1
Dark Emerald Pearl
TOY6M1
W9542
PM72B
4595
46589
TOY6M1
99746
6M1
6M3
Silver Spruce Metallic
TOY6M3
W9514
D381B
4474
45931
TOY6M3
99679
6M3
6N7
Sierra Green Metallic
TOY6N7
F1036
7P07B
5047
51163
TOY6N7
61391
6N7
6P2
Classic Green Pearl
TOY6P2
F1850
BAA7B
5173
52889
TOY6P2
61953
6P2
6P3
Deep Jewel
Grean Pearl
TOY6P3
F1805
ARD3B
5166
52887
TOY6P3
61928
6P3
6P4
Surfside Green Mica
TOY6P4
F2690
GNL1B
5289
54293
TOY6P4
64018
6P4
6Q7
Imperial Jade Mica
TOY6Q7
F3750
KWC2B
5423
56660
TOY6Q7
68096
6Q7
6R1
Woodland Pearl
TOY6R1
F7147
LVT6B
5566
57230
TOY6R1
65321
6R1
6R3
Fairway Green Pearl
TOY6R3
F5140
NPD9B
5567
57930
TOY6R3
65706
6R3
760
Mystic Teal Mica
TOY760
F3533
LCP2B
5445
56258
TOY760
65225
760
762
Aqua Blue Metallic
TOY762
F8543
PEJ8B
5595
58693
TOY762
56812
762
8L3
Blue Velvet Pearl
TOY8L3
F2239
FRC7B
5328
54032
TOY8L3
54676
8L3
8L4
Atlantis Blue Mica
TOY8L4
F1898
BGT9B
19705
52994
TOY8L4
54483
8L4
8L5
Royal Sapphire Blue
TOY8L5
F2728
HDJ4B
5329
54485
TOY8L5
55068
8L5
8L7
Stellar Blue Pearl
TOY8L7
F2059
ETB9B
5206
53072
TOY8L7
54562
8L7
8L9
Denim Blue Mica
TOY8L9
F2722
JCD1B
5443
54872
TOY8L9
55325
8L9
8M5
Mista Blue Mica
TOY8M5
F3562
KBA1B
5434
56261
TOY8M5
55825
8M5
8M8
Twilight Blue Pearl
TOY8M8
F7274
LXY2B
190925
57452
TOY8M8
56542
8M8
8N1
Horizon Blue Metallic
TOY8N1
F5223
PEC2B
5527
58341
TOY8N1
56813
8N1
930
Blue Dusk Pearl
TOY930
F2723
HRE6B
5330
54758
TOY930
40713
930
931
Frosted Iris Metallic
TOY931
F2724
HRE7B
5331
54759
TOY931
40714
931
938
Mystic Purple Mica
TOY938
F3532
KWB7B
5420
56656
TOY938
40930
938
AUTOCOLOR
PPG
WILLIAMS
SIKKENS
HECKER
STANDOX
Page 3 of 5
1999 PAINT AND REFINISH FORMULA CODES – PA002–99
Land Cruiser
Cladding
Codes
Paint
Applications &
Types
ICI
SHERWIN
SPIES–
COLOR
CODE
COLOR NAME
BASF
DUPONT
UCA46
Cashmere
Beige Metallic
TOYUCA46
H9752
D700B
27345
46754
TOYUA46
20631
UCA46
UCA76
Medium Gray Metallic
TOYA76
F1114
7VT6B
35973
51188
TOY9418
72547
UCA76
UCA78
Dark Taupe Metallic
TOY9420
TOYUCA78
F1116
27888
51186
80371
UCA78
7VV1B
CAM
AVL
COLOR
CODE
040
049
051
056
181
199
1A0
1A2
1A3
1A5
1B1
1B2
1B9
1C0
1C3
1C4
1C7
1C8
202
204
205
3E5
3H7
3J8
3K4
3L2
3L5
3M5
3M6
3M8
3M9
Page 4 of 5
March 12, 1999
COR
SOL
AUTOCOLOR
CEL
SNA
PPG
WILLIAMS
RAV
RAVev
SIKKENS
4RN
HECKER
TAC
STANDOX
L–C
1999 PAINT AND REFINISH FORMULA CODES – PA002–99
Paint
Applications &
Types
(Continued)
COLOR
CODE
COR
SOL
CAM
AVL
CEL
March 12, 1999
SNA
RAV
RAVev
4RN
TAC
L–C
3N1
3N2
3N5
3N6
4J6
4M4
4M7
4M9
4N5
4N7
4P1
4P3
4P5
4P6
578
6M1
6M3
6N7
6P2
6P3
6P4
6Q7
6R1
6R3
760
762
8L3
8L4
8L5
8L7
8L9
8M5
8M8
8N1
930
931
938
Page 5 of 5
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 14, 2002
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
Tools &
Material
REFINISHING REPLACEMENT
BUMPER COVERS
Models:
All ’83 – ’03 Models
In cases where a bumper cover is being replaced, a special preparation process is
necessary to assure the refinish is customer acceptable. This bulletin provides the
recommended refinishing procedure for new bumper covers.
S All 1983 – 2003 model year Toyota vehicles.
TOOLS & MATERIALS
QUANTITY
Mild Soap –– Ph neutral (no wax type)
3Mt Car Shampoo (or equivalent)
Sanding Pad
3Mt ScotchBrite (Gray) 37448
Sanding Paste
Wax, Grease, & Silicone Remover
Plastic Part Adhesion Promoter
See Paint Manufacturer’s Recommendations
Primer and Paint
Warranty
Information
Refinishing
Procedure
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
1. Mix a solution of mild soap (car wash soap with no wax additives) and clean water.
NOTE:
Carefully follow mixing instructions on the soap container. Too much soap or too
much water may cause surface contamination or rinsing difficulty.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PAINT
PA003-02
Title:
REFINISHING REPLACEMENT BUMPER COVERS – PA003-02
Refinishing
Procedure
(Continued)
June 14, 2002
2. Scrub the bumper covers with the soap and water solution, making sure all
difficult–to–reach areas are thoroughly cleaned.
3. Rinse the entire bumper cover with clean deionized water, making sure all
difficult–to–reach areas are thoroughly rinsed.
4. Dry the surface with a clean towel before water dries on the surface. Clean, dry
compressed air from an oil–less compressor may be substituted for drying with a
towel.
5. Degrease the surface with a wax, grease, and silicone remover.
NOTE:
Lacquer thinner or brake cleaner will NOT remove silicone. You MUST use a wax,
grease, and silicone remover. Carefully follow application instructions on the container
label. Fish eyes or other paint irregularities may result from not following instructions.
6. Apply a generous amount of sanding paste with a gray 3Mt ScotchBrite pad. Only a
gray pad should be used during the sanding process. Sand the entire bumper cover
surface. Be sure all difficult–to–reach areas are thoroughly sanded.
7. Clean the entire bumper cover with car wash soap and water. Be sure all
difficult–to–reach areas are thoroughly cleaned.
8. Rinse the entire bumper with clean deionized water. Be sure all difficult–to–reach
areas are thoroughly rinsed.
9. Degrease the surface with an anti–static plastic parts cleaner and a white body shop
towel or paper towel.
NOTE:
Never use a red shop towel to wipe the surface (contains silicone).
10. Assure the bumper is firmly held in place to a steady fixture.
11. Apply a plastic parts adhesion promoter to the surface, according to the
manufacturer ’s recommendations.
12. Apply plastic parts primer to the surface, according to the paint manufacturer’s
recommendations.
13. Since bumpers are made of flexible plastic urethane material, use a two–part
urethane finish paint system with plasticizer (flex agent) for all bumper and cladding
repairs. Apply the appropriate top coat to the surface, according to the paint
manufacturer ’s recommendations.
14. If heat is applied to cure the paint, assure the surface temperature does not exceed
80C (176F.)
For additional information concerning the refinish process for plastic bumpers/cladding,
please contact your respective refinish paint manufacturer’s local representative.
Page 2 of 2
Wash with
Soap & Water
Rinse &
Towel Dry
Degrease
Step 1
Scrub with
Sanding
Paste
Wash with
Soap & Water
Rinse &
Towel Dry
Degrease
Step 2
Apply
Adhesion
Promoter
Apply
Primer
Apply Top
Coat
Technical Service
BULLETIN
TWO-TONE PAINT COLOR
Models:
’99 Camry Limited Edition
June 11, 1999
Introduction
Affected
Vehicles
The following information outlines the two–tone painting scheme on 1999 Camry Limited
Edition.
S 1999 Camry Limited Edition
Production
Change
Information
Warranty
Information
COLOR NO.
COMBINATION
TWO–TONE NAMES
2GP
4M7/1B2
Oyster Pearl/Antique Sage
Pearl accent
28Y
051/4M7
Diamond White Pearl/
Oyster Pearl Accent
OPCODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
PAINT
PA004–99
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
January 7, 2000
Introduction
2000 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN
INFORMATION
Models:
All Models
Toyota Technical Service Bulletins (TSBs) continue to be one of the most current sources
of technical information available. To ensure complete access to this reference source,
use the following steps:
S All 1999 Technical Service Bulletins should be relocated to a temporary binder.
S Place this bulletin along with all 2000 TSBs into the emptied TSB binder.
S During the month of March, all dealers will receive bound books containing all TSBs
issued in 1999. Upon receipt, discard all 1999 TSBs and refer only to the bound
book for reference.
S Additional copies of 1994 through 2000 TSBs are available to all Toyota dealerships
through the Toyota Non–Parts System (MDC NPM System) by using the following
Part Number designation:
TSB Part Number Prefix
TSB Chapter Code
Chapter Code Sequence Number
Year
00406
Parts
Information
*
– PG 001 – 99
MATERIAL DESCRIPTION
PART NUMBER
TSB Binder, tabs and all 2000 bulletins issued to date
TSB00
New TSB Binder and tabs ONLY
00406–61012
1999 TSB Bound Book
00442–99002*
1998 TSB Bound Book
00442–98005
1997 TSB Bound Book
00442–97011
1996 TSB Bound Book
00442–97003
1995 TSB Bound Book
00401–43055
Available in March, 2000.
NOTE:
If you have any questions concerning Toyota Technical Service Bulletins, please
contact your District Service Manager.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG001–00
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
All Models
February 28, 2003
Introduction
Corrections have been made in the repair manuals listed below. Corrections available
in the last quarter are marked in red. The Toyota Technical Information system (TIS) is
the best way to access up–to–date service information.
NOTE:
When ordering a technical publication (i.e., Repair Manual, Electrical Wiring Diagram)
from the MDC, any Correction Page(s) associated with that particular Publication will
automatically be included with your order.
Parts
Information
Correction Pages are available through the Dealer Support Material Network (MDC NPM
System) via the corresponding part numbers from the following table.
Publication
4Runner
Number
2003 4Runner . . . . . . . . RM1001–U1 . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM1001–U2 . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM1001–U1 . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page(s)
Part Number
03–36 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM100–12131
29–6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
29–23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
25–18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM100–22146
26–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
26–17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
27–6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
27–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
27–29 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
27–31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
27–32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
27–34 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
27–36 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
27–37 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–614 to 05–616 . . 00400–RM100–12156
05–712 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–713 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–713–1 to 05–713–7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–724 to 05–737 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–811 to 05–813 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Page 1 of 4
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX
PG001-03
Title:
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG001-03
Publication
Number
February 28, 2003
Page(s)
Part Number
Avalon
2000 Avalon . . . . . . . . . . RM746–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
2001 Avalon . . . . . . . . . . RM808–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
2002 Avalon . . . . . . . . . . RM872–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
BE–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM746–2167B
BE–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM808–2166B
BE–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–96 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM872–2088B
BE–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM872–2165B
BE–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Camry
2002 Camry . . . . . . . . . . EWD461U . . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
2003 Camry . . . . . . . . . . EWD506U . . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
45 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD46–12107
77 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
89 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
317 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
45 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD50–62108
77 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
89 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
319 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Corolla
Highlander
Page 2 of 4
2003 Corolla . . . . . . . . . . EWD484U . . . . . 49 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD48–42150
2001 Highlander . . . . . . RM837–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
2002 Highlander . . . . . . RM918–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
2003 Highlander . . . . . . RM987–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
11–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM837–2140B
11–16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM918–2141B
11–16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM987–2157B
11–14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–14–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–14–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–27 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
11–27–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG001-03
Publication
Number
February 28, 2003
Page(s)
Part Number
Matrix
2003 Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . EWD486U . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM940–U1 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM940–U2 . . . .
55 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD48–62151
05–833 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM940–2116
05–834 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–820 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM940–2159
05–821 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–825 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–826 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–829 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–830 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–837 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–840 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
73–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM940–2163B
MR2 Spyder
2001 MR2 Spyder . . . . . RM801–U1 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
2002 MR2 Spyder . . . . . RM900–U1 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM900–U2 . . . .
DI–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM801–2105
DI–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–150 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–151 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–152 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–153 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–183 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–184 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–184–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–184–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM900–2106
DI–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–151 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–152 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–153 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–154 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–184 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–185 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–186 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–187 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BO–46 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM900–2137
Prius
2001 Prius . . . . . . . . . . . . RM778–U1 . . . . DI–680 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM778–2095
2002 Prius . . . . . . . . . . . . RM883–U1 . . . . DI–687 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM883–2096
2003 Prius . . . . . . . . . . . . RM957–U1 . . . . DI–687 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM957–2097
Page 3 of 4
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG001-03
Publication
Number
February 28, 2003
Page(s)
Part Number
Sequoia
2003 Sequoia . . . . . . . . . RM959–U1 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
DI–304 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–12128
DI–312 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–313 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–321 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–325 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–326 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–330 to DI–333 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–335 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–340 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–347 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–357 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–358 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–360 to DI–362 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–372 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–373 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–377 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–377–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Sienna
2001 Sienna . . . . . . . . . . EWD420U . . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
2002 Sienna . . . . . . . . . . EWD454U . . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
2003 Sienna . . . . . . . . . . EWD490U . . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
37 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD42–2121
64 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
267 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
37 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD45–2122
64 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
271 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
37 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD49–02123
64 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
271 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Tacoma
Tundra
Page 4 of 4
2002 Tacoma . . . . . . . . . RM921–U1 . . . . DI–510 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM921–2089
2000 Tundra . . . . . . . . . . EWD367U . . . . .
......................................
......................................
2001 Tundra . . . . . . . . . . EWD429U . . . . .
......................................
......................................
2002 Tundra . . . . . . . . . . EWD468U . . . . .
......................................
......................................
129 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD36–72133
222 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M28 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
121 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD42–92134
208 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
121 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD46–82135
208 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
M26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Models:
All Models
December 31, 2000
Introduction
Corrections have been made in the repair manuals listed below. Corrections available in
the last quarter are marked in red, and have already been mailed to all dealers.
NOTE:
When ordering a technical publication (i.e. Repair Manual, Electrical Wiring Diagram)
from the MDC, and Correction Page(s) associated with that particular Publication will
automatically be included with your order.
Parts
Information
Correction Pages are available through the Dealer Support Material Network (MDC NPM
System) via the corresponding part numbers from the following table:
Publication
Number
Page(s)
Part Number
Avalon
2001 Avalon . . . . . . . . RM746–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
DI–259 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM746–Z107
DI–260 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–311 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–312 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–314 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–316 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–317–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–317–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Celica
2000 Celica . . . . . . . . . RM744–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM744–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
SS–45 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM744–9094A
SS–47 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SS–52 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–02 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM744–9094B
SA–41 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–44 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–33 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–51 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
EM–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM744–Z066
EM–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
EM–6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
EM–7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
EM–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
EM–10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
EM–11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
EM–12–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SF–10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM744–Z130
SF–12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SF–13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SF–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 4
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX
PG002–00
Title:
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002-00 Revised
Publication
Number
December 31, 2000
Page(s)
Part Number
Celica
(Continued)
2001 Celica . . . . . . . . . RM818–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
SF–10
SF–12
SF–13
SF–15
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM818–Z130
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
ECHO
2000 ECHO . . . . . . . . RM750–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
2001 ECHO . . . . . . . . RM816–U . . . . . .
BR–16
BR–27
BR–28
BR–31
PP–50
SS–37
SS–38
BR–32
BR–32
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM591–8121
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM591–8063
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM750–Z140
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM816–Z140
Highlander
Land Cruiser
MR2 Spyder
Page 2 of 4
2001 Highlander . . . . EWD442–U . . . . . 239 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD44–2Z149
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
2000 Land Cruiser . . . RM722–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM722–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
DI–305 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM722–Z018
DI–306 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–307 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–308 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SS–30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM722–9093A
SS–31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM722–9093B
SA–37 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–40 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–41 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–42 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–43 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–44 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–46 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–47 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–48 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–49 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–50 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–52 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–53 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–54 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–55 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–56 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–57 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BR–10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM722–Z038
2000 MR2 . . . . . . . . . . RM760–U . . . . . . BR–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM760–Z141
2001 MR2 . . . . . . . . . . RM801–U . . . . . . BR–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM801–Z141
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002-00 Revised
Publication
Number
December 31, 2000
Page(s)
Part Number
Prius
2001 Prius . . . . . . . . . . BRM09–6E . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM778–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM778–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
BP–17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–BRM09–6Z112
BP–18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BP–33 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BP–48 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BP–49 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BP–54 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BP–55 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
PC–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–105 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM778–Z093
DI–106 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SS–21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM778–Z123
DI–504 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–593–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–593–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–593–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
HV–22 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–661 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM778–Z120A
DI–661–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–665 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–666 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–670 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–671 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–22 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM778–Z151
BE–23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–44 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM778–Z120B
BE–46–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
RAV4
1996 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . RM447–U . . . . . .
1997 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . RM505–U . . . . . .
1998 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . RM595–U . . . . . .
1999 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . RM668–U2 . . . . .
2000 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . RM711–U2 . . . . .
2001 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . RM797–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM797–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
SA–62 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM447–Z071
SA–66 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM505–Z071
SA–79 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM595–Z071
SA–79 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM668–Z071
SA–79 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM711–Z071
DI–489 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM797–Z096
SS–42 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM797–Z106A
SA–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM797–Z106B
SA–7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–69 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM797–Z071
Sequoia
Sienna
2001 Sequoia . . . . . . . RM832–U1 . . . . . SS–31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM832–Z139
1998 Sienna . . . . . . . . RM594–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
1999 Sienna . . . . . . . . RM657–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
SR–37
SR–47
SR–48
SR–37
SR–47
SR–48
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM594–9095
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM657–9095
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
Page 3 of 4
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002-00 Revised
Publication
Number
Page(s)
December 31, 2000
Part Number
Sienna
(Continued)
2000 Sienna . . . . . . . . RM701–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
SR–37 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM701–9095
SR–47 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–48 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–387 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM701–Z121
DI–388 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–389 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–389–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–389–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–389–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Tacoma
1998 Tacoma . . . . . . . RM576–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
1998 Tacoma Suppl. . RM614–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
1999 Tacoma . . . . . . . RM673–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM673–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
2000 Tacoma . . . . . . . RM712–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM712–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
2001 Tacoma . . . . . . . RM835–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
DI–349 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM576–Z105
DI–350 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
PP–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM614–9123
PP–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SS–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SS–72 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM673–9123A
DI–373 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM673–Z105
DI–374 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM673–9123B
SA–26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–28 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SS–73 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM712–9123A
DI–415 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM712–Z105
DI–416 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM712–9123B
SA–26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–28 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–340 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM835–Z105
DI–341 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Tundra
Page 4 of 4
2000 Tundra . . . . . . . . RM682–U2 . . . . . TR–43 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM682–Z055
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TR–44 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TR–45 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Models:
All Models
December 24, 1999
Introduction
Corrections have been made in the repair manuals listed below. Corrections available in
the last quarter are marked in red, and have already been mailed to all dealers.
Parts
Information
Correction Pages are available through the Dealer Support Material Network (MDC NPM
System) via the corresponding part numbers from the following table:
NOTE:
When ordering a technical publication (i.e. Repair Manual, Electrical Wiring Diagram)
from the MDC, and Correction Page(s) associated with that particular Publication will
automatically be included with your order.
Publication
Number
Page(s)
Part Number
Avalon
1999 Avalon . . . . . . . . RM598–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM656–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
BE–74 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM598–8029
BE–76 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–77 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–78 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–79 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–80 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–81 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–82 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–83 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–84 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–85 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–86 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–87 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–80 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–81 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–82 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–116 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM656–8121
DI–121 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–123 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–136 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
4Runner
1998 4Runner . . . . . . RM580–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
1999 4Runner . . . . . . RM663–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
DI–331 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM580–8087
DI–338 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–49 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM663–9005
BE–92 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM663–8117
Camry
1998 Camry . . . . . . . . RM589–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM589–U2 . . . . .
1999 Camry . . . . . . . . RM654–U2 . . . . .
DI–107 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM580–8087
DI–112 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–127 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM589–9002
SA–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM654–9002
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 5
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX
PG002–99
Title:
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002-99 REVISED
Publication
Number
Page(s)
December 24, 1999
Part Number
Celica
1998 Celica . . . . . . . . . RM613–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
1999 Celica . . . . . . . . . RM660–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
2000 Celica . . . . . . . . . RM774–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM774–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
D1–90 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM598–8029
D1–95 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–97 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–110 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM613–9002
D1–96 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM660–8121
D1–101 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–103 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–116 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM660–8121
SA–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM660–9002
D1–280 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM774–9063
SS–47 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM774–9078A
SS–52 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–41 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM774–9078B
SA–44 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–50 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–61 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–71 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–72 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–33 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–51 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Celica
1998 Corolla . . . . . . . . RM591–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
1999 Corolla . . . . . . . . RM655–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
D1–71 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM591–8121
D1–75 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–77 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–90 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–181 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM591–8063
D1–182 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–183 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–185 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–187 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–188 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–189 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–190 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–191 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–194 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–198 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–199 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–201 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–202 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–203 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–205 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–206 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–208 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–210 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–72 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM655–8121
D1–76 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–78 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Page 2 of 5
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002–99 Revised
Publication
Corolla
(Continued)
Land Cruiser
Number
Page(s)
December 24, 1999
Part Number
1999 Corolla . . . . . . . . RM665–U . . . . . . D1–91 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM655–8121
1998 Land Cruiser . . . RM615–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM615–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM615–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
1999 Land Cruiser . . . RM661–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM661–U2 . . . . .
PP–33 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
PP–34 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
PP–35 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
PP–36 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
SS–26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–07 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–20 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–29 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–33 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–41 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–44 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–45 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
TR–46 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
D1–293 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–8046
D1–299 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–453 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–8117
SS–29 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–9017
EM–59 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–9038
BE–74 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–9022
BR–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–8031
SA–14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–9017A
SA–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–24 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–9028
SR–26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–27 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–28 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–122 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–8121
D1–127 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–129 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–142 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–311 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–316 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–318 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–331 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–471 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–8117
SS–30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–9017
BE–76 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–9022
Page 3 of 5
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002-99 REVISED
Publication
Number
Page(s)
December 24, 1999
Part Number
Land Cruiser
(Continued)
1999 Land Cruiser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
EM–59 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–9038
SA–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–9017A
SA–16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–9028
SR–28 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–29 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–33 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SR–34 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Sienna
1998 Sienna . . . . . . . . RM594–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
1999 Sienna . . . . . . . . RM657–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
2000 Sienna . . . . . . . . RM701–U . . . . . .
.....................................
BO–14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM594–9023
BO–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BO–20 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–186 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM594–9065
D1–187 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–190 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–191 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–192 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–193 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–194 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–195 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–196 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–219 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM594–8088
D1–224 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–225 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–385 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM594–8066
D1–386 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–389 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM594–9002
BE–84 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM657–9011
BO–14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM657–9021
BO–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BO–20 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–219 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM657–9065
D1–220 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–223 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–224 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–225 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–226 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–227 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–228 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–229 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–253 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM657–8088
D1–257 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–258 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM657–9022
D1–217 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM701–9065
D1–218 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Page 4 of 5
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002–99 Revised
Publication
Number
December 24, 1999
Page(s)
Part Number
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM701–9065
................................ ↓
................................ ↓
................................ ↓
................................ ↓
................................ ↓
................................ ↓
Sienna
(Continued)
2000 Sienna . . . . . . . . RM701–U . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
D1–221
D1–222
D1–223
D1–224
D1–225
D1–226
D1–227
Solara
1999 Solara . . . . . . . . RM649–U1 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
.....................................
D1–110 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM649–8121
D1–115 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–117 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–286 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–291 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–293 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
D1–306 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM594–9002
Supra
1999 Supra . . . . . . . . . RM408–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
1996 Supra . . . . . . . . . RM444 . . . . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
1997 Supra . . . . . . . . . RM502 . . . . . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
1998 Supra . . . . . . . . . RM587–U1 . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM587–U2 . . . . .
.....................................
.....................................
SA–20
SA–26
SA–28
SA–18
SA–19
SA–24
SA–18
SA–19
SA–24
PP–69
SA–19
SA–28
SA–31
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM408–9007
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM444–9007
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM502–9007
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM587–9007A
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM587–9007B
................................. ↓
................................. ↓
Tacoma
1998 Tacoma . . . . . . . RM576–U1 . . . . . D1–351 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM576–8038
Tundra
2000 Tundra . . . . . . . . RM682–U1 . . . . . SS–76 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM682–9077A
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM682–U2 . . . . . BR–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM682–9077B
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BR–13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Page 5 of 5
Models:
All Models
September 30, 2002
Introduction
Corrections have been made in the repair manuals listed below. Corrections available
in the last quarter are marked in red, have already been mailed to all dealers, and are
updated in TIS.
NOTE:
When ordering a technical publication (i.e., Repair Manual, Electrical Wiring Diagram)
from the MDC, any Correction Page(s) associated with that particular Publication will
automatically be included with your order.
Parts
Information
Correction Pages are available through the Dealer Support Material Network (MDC NPM
System) via the corresponding part numbers from the following table.
Publication
4Runner
Number
Page(s)
Part Number
2001 4Runner . . . . . . . . RM796–U1 . . . . DI–477 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM796–2086
2002 4Runner . . . . . . . . EWD471–U . . . . 158 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD471–2050
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM887–U1 . . . . DI–487 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM887–2087
Avalon
2002 Avalon . . . . . . . . . . EWD45–3U . . . .
......................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM872–U1 . . . .
......................................
258 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD45–32038
21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–232 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM872–2054
DI–530 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM872–2052
Camry
1998 Camry . . . . . . . . . . RM589–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
1999 Camry . . . . . . . . . . RM654–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
2000 Camry . . . . . . . . . . RM742–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
2001 Camry . . . . . . . . . . RM819–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
BE–64
BE–65
BE–66
BE–65
BE–66
BE–67
BE–65
BE–66
BE–67
BE–66
BE–67
BE–68
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM589–2005B
............................... ↓
............................... ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM654–2005B
............................... ↓
............................... ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM742–2005B
............................... ↓
............................... ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM819–2005B
............................... ↓
............................... ↓
Page 1 of 3
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX
PG002-02
Title:
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002-02 Revised
Publication
Camry
(Continued)
Number
2002 Camry . . . . . . . . . . EWD46–1U . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM881–U1 . . . .
......................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM881–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
September 30, 2002
Page(s)
Part Number
77 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD46–12039
05–418 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM881–2054
05–1230 . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM881–2077
73–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM881–2060B
73–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
73–10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Celica
2000 Celica . . . . . . . . . . . RM744–U1 . . . . DI–510 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM744–2074
2001 Celica . . . . . . . . . . . RM818–U1 . . . . DI–511 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM818–2075
2002 Celica . . . . . . . . . . . RM902–U1 . . . . DI–514 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM902–2076
Corolla
2003 Corolla . . . . . . . . . . RM938–U1 . . . . 05–169 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM938–2054
ECHO
Highlander
Land Cruiser
Prius
Page 2 of 3
2000 ECHO . . . . . . . . . . RM750–U . . . . .
......................................
2001 ECHO . . . . . . . . . . RM816–U . . . . .
......................................
2002 ECHO . . . . . . . . . . RM884–U . . . . .
......................................
BE–66 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM750–2011
BE–66–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–66 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM816–2011
BE–66–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–66 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM884–2011
BE–66–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
2002 Highlander . . . . . . RM918–U1 . . . . 05–919 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM918–2053
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM918–U2 . . . . 82–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM918–2058B
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
1998 Land Cruiser . . . . . RM615–U2 . . . .
......................................
1999 Land Cruiser . . . . . RM661–U2 . . . .
......................................
2000 Land Cruiser . . . . . RM722–U2 . . . .
......................................
2001 Land Cruiser . . . . . RM795–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
2002 Land Cruiser . . . . . RM893–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
BE–80
BE–81
BE–82
BE–83
BE–82
BE–83
BE–91
BE–92
BE–93
BE–91
BE–92
BE–93
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM615–2006B
............................... ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–2006B
............................... ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM722–2006B
............................... ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM795–2006B
............................... ↓
............................... ↓
. . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM893–2006B
............................... ↓
............................... ↓
2001 Prius . . . . . . . . . . . . RM778–U1 . . . . DI–654 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM778–2072
2002 Prius . . . . . . . . . . . . RM883–U1 . . . . DI–669 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM883–2073
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG002-02 Revised
Publication
RAV4
Number
2001 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . . . RM797–U1 . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM797–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
2002 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . . . RM891–U1 . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM891–U2 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
......................................
September 30, 2002
Page(s)
Part Number
DI–450 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM797–2084
BE–63 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM797–2012B
BO–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM797–2040B
BO–10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BO–11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BO–11–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–450 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM891–2085
BE–64 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM891–2012B
BO–9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM891–2040B
BO–10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BO–11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BO–11–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Sequoia
2002 Sequoia . . . . . . . . . RM886–U1 . . . . DI–253 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM886–2054
Sienna
1998 Sienna . . . . . . . . . . RM594–U . . . . . BE–59 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM594–2013
1999 Sienna . . . . . . . . . . RM657–U . . . . . BE–60 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM657–2013
2000 Sienna . . . . . . . . . . RM701–U . . . . . BE–60 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM701–2013
Solara
2002 Solara . . . . . . . . . . RM882–U1 . . . . DI–446 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM882–2054
Tacoma
2002 Tacoma . . . . . . . . . EWD478–U . . . . 71 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD–2051
...................................... 4 .................................... ↓
Tundra
2002 Tundra . . . . . . . . . . RM885–U1 . . . . DI–371 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM885–2054
Page 3 of 3
PRODUCT GENERAL
INFORMATION
PG95-006
JULY 21, 1995
ALL MODELS
STANDARD BOLT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Page 1 of 1
The following bolt mark and class identification information is currently not included in the Standard
Bolt Torque Specifications found in the Introduction section of each Toyota Repair Manual.
BOLT
MARK
CLASS
(Hexagon flange bolt or
Hexagon bolt with washer)
4 Protruding Lines
9T
(Hexagon flange bolt or
Hexagon bolt with washer)
5 Protruding Lines
10T
(Hexagon flange bolt or
Hexagon bolt with washer)
6 Protruding Lines
11T
SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR STANDARD BOLTS
CLASS
9T
10T
11T
DIAMETER
mm
PITCH
mm
SPECIFIED TORQUE
HEXAGON HEAD BOLT
HEXAGON FLANGE BOLT
NSm
kgfScm ftSlbf
NSm
kgfScm
ftSlbf
8
1.25
34
340
25
37
380
27
10
1.25
70
710
51
78
790
57
12
1.25
125
1300
94
140
1450
105
8
1.25
38
390
28
42
430
31
10
1.25
78
800
58
88
890
64
12
1.25
140
1450
105
155
1600
116
8
1.25
42
430
31
47
480
35
10
1.25
87
890
64
97
990
72
12
1.25
155
1600
116
175
1800
130
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES U.S.A., INC.
March 31, 2000
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
CA/50 STATE CERTIFIED EMISSION
CONTROL UNDERHOOD LABEL
ORDERING
Models:
All Models
It is no longer necessary to fax the CA/50 State Emission Label Order Form to TMS.
California (CA) and 50 State Certified underhood emission control labels (emission
labels) may now be obtained through your dealership Parts Department utilizing standard
replacement parts ordering procedures via the TDN. Follow the guidelines outlined in
this TSB to ensure proper label application.
S All model year Toyota Vehicles.
We have included tables reflecting 1997 – 2000 MY CA and 50 State Emission Label
part number information for your convenience. Please continue to consult the
Electronic Parts Catalog (EPC) or the parts microfiche for information regarding other
model years as well as Federal Emission label part numbers.
NOTE:
Although the California Smog Impact Fee has been discontinued, dealers are still
required by regulation to verify the correct emission label is installed on the correct
vehicle.
REGULATIONS:
The United States Clean Air Act, Title II, Sections 202, 203, 205, and 207 mandates that
the emission control label must correctly match the emissions equipment on the
vehicle. Any person violating this requirement is subject to applicable State penalties
and a Federal civil penalty of no more than $25,000 for each instance.
Personnel at franchised dealerships are authorized to affix such labels to vehicles and
are, therefore, subject to this regulation and the attendant penalties.
S Do not sell the labels over the counter. Always install the label on the vehicle.
S Never install a California and/or 50 State Label on a vehicle that is not a
California/50 State Emission Certified Vehicle.
S Do not install Federal Emission labels on vehicles that are not Federal
Emissions Certified.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 6
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
Technical Service
BULLETIN
PG006–00
Title:
CA/50 STATE CERTIFIED EMISSION CONTROL UNDERHOOD LABEL ORDERING – PG006–00
Label
Ordering
Procedure
March 31, 2000
To ensure that the emission control labels are affixed to the correct vehicle, it is
necessary to follow these procedures:
1. Record the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) from the vehicle requiring a
replacement label.
2. A dealership associate (must be
assigned by Parts Manager), with
authorized TDN access, must confirm
the emissions equipment of the
vehicle by referring to the following
accessory codes:
S CA – California Certified
S FE – 50 State Certified
S RE – Federal Certified
S CN – California and New York
Certified
3. Once the emissions equipment information is verified, obtain the part number
information by referring to the attached table for 1998 – 2000 MY vehicles or
consulting the EPC/microfiche for other Toyota vehicles, including Federal
Specification Vehicles.
4. Order the label through your Parts Department, using normal parts ordering
procedures via the TDN.
5. When the part arrives, verify that the emission label matches the emissions
equipment on the vehicle. This will ensure the correct label is affixed to the vehicle.
Page 2 of 6
CA/50 STATE CERTIFIED EMISSION CONTROL UNDERHOOD LABEL ORDERING – PG006–00
1997 MY CA/50
State Certified
Emission
Control Labels
March 31, 2000
MODEL
ENGINE NAME
TRANSMISSION
EMISSIONS*
PART NUMBERS
Tercel
5E–FE
All
USA
11298–11452
Paseo
5E–FE
All
CA
11298–11452
4A–FE
All
CA
11298–1D060
7A–FE
All
CA
11298–1D090
7A–FE
All
CA
11298–1D120
5S–FE
All
CA
11298–7A390
5S–FE
M/TM
CA
11298–7A330
5S–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–7A350
1MZ–FE
All
CA
11298–20110
2JZ–GE
All
USA
11298–46121
2JZ–GTE
All
USA
11298–46102
Avalon
1MZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–20110
Previa
2TZ–FZE
A/TM
USA
11298–76083
RAV4
3S–FE
All
CA
11298–7A410
3RZ–FE (2WD)
All
USA
11298–75220
3RZ–FE (4WD)
All
USA
11298–75260
5VZ–FE
All
CA
11298–62450
2RZ–FE (2WD)
All
CA
11298–75210
3RZ–FE (4WD)
M/TM
CA
11298–75200
3RZ–FE (4WD)
All
USA
11298–75220
5VZ–FE
(2WD XtraCab)
All
USA
11298–62430
5VZ–FE
(4WD RegCab)
M/TM
USA
11298–62430
5VZ–FE
(4WD XtraCab)
All
CA
11298–62450
3RZ–FE (2WD)
All
USA
11298–75240
T 100
T–100
5VZ–FE
(2WD/4WD)
All
CA
11298–62500
Land Cruiser
1FZ–FE
A/TM
USA
11298–66070
Corolla
Celica
Camry
S pra
Supra
4Runner
Tacoma
*
CA = California Emission Specification, USA = 50 State Emission Specification
Page 3 of 6
CA/50 STATE CERTIFIED EMISSION CONTROL UNDERHOOD LABEL ORDERING – PG006–00
1998 MY CA/50
State Certified
Emission
Control Labels
MODEL
ENGINE NAME
TRANSMISSION
EMISSIONS*
PART NUMBERS
Tercel
5E–FE
All
CA
11298–11453
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
CA
11298–22040
Celica
5S–FE
All
CA
11298–7A470
5S–FE
All
CA
11298–7A430
1MZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–20160
1MZ–FE
M/TM
CA
11298–20190
Supra
2JZ–GE
A/TM
CA
11298–46122
Avalon
1MZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–20160
Sienna
1MZ–FE
All
CA
11298–20140
RAV4
3S–FE
All
CA
11298–7A510
3RZ–FE (2WD)
All
CA
11298–75320
3RZ–FE (4WD)
All
CA
11298–75380
5VZ–FE
All
CA
11298–62540
2RZ–FE (2WD)
All
CA
11298–75300
3RZ–FE (4WD)
M/TM
CA
11298–75310
3RZ–FE (4WD)
A/TM
CA
11298–75320
5VZ–FE (2WD)
All
CA
11298–62530
5VZ–FE
(4WD XtraCab)
All
CA
11298–62540
3RZ–FE (2WD)
All
USA
11298–75360
T 100
T–100
5VZ–FE
(2WD/4WD)
All
CA
11298–62580
Land Cruiser
2UZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–50200
Camry
4Runner
Tacoma
*
Page 4 of 6
March 31, 2000
CA = California Emission Specification, USA = 50 State Emission Specification
CA/50 STATE CERTIFIED EMISSION CONTROL UNDERHOOD LABEL ORDERING – PG006–00
1999 MY CA/50
State Certified
Emission
Control Labels
MODEL
ENGINE NAME
TRANSMISSION
EMISSIONS*
PART NUMBERS
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
CA
11298–22041
Celica
5S–FE
All
CA
11298–7A560
5S–FE
All
CA
11298–7A521
1MZ–FE
M/TM
USA
11298–20240
1MZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–20181
5S–FE
All
CA
11298–7A521
1MZ–FE
M/TM
USA
11298–20240
1MZ–FE
A/TM
USA
11298–20181
Avalon
1MZ–FE
All
CA
11298–20181
Sienna
1MZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–20270
RAV4
3S–FE
(2WD/4WD)
All
CA
11298–7A541
3RZ–FE
(2WD/4WD)
All
USA
11298–75400
5VZ–FE
(2WD/4WD)
All
CA
11298–62660
2RZ–FE (2WD)
All
USA
11298–75460
3RZ–FE
(PreRunner/4WD)
A/TM
USA
11298–75470
3RZ–FE (4WD)
M/TM
CA
11298–75480
3RZ–FE
(2WD XtraCab)
A/TM
USA
11298–75400
5VZ–FE
(2WD XtraCab)
All
USA
11298–62590
5VZ–FE
(PreRunner/4WD)
All
USA
11298–62600
2UZ–FE
A/TM
USA
11298–50181
Camry
Camry Solara
4R nner
4Runner
Tacoma
Land Cruiser
*
March 31, 2000
CA = California Emission Specification, USA = 50 State Emission Specification
Page 5 of 6
CA/50 STATE CERTIFIED EMISSION CONTROL UNDERHOOD LABEL ORDERING – PG006–00
2000 MY CA/50
State Certified
Emission
Control Labels
March 31, 2000
MODEL
ENGINE NAME
TRANSMISSION
EMISSIONS*
PART NUMBERS
ECHO
1NZ–FE
All
USA
11298–21010
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
USA
11298–22032
1ZZ–FE
All
USA
11298–22080
2ZZ–GE
All
USA
11298–22050
5S–FE
All
USA
11298–7A590
1MZ–FE
M/TM
USA
11298–20320
1MZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–20310
5S–FE
All
USA
11298–7A590
1MZ–FE
M/TM
USA
11298–20320
1MZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–20310
Celica
Camry
Camry Solara
Camry Solara
Convertible
5S–FE
A/TM
USA
11298–7A590
1MZ–FE
A/TM
CA
11298–20310
Camry (CNG)
5S–FNE
A/TM
USA
11298–7A640
Avalon
1MZ–FE
A/TM
USA
11298–20290
Sienna
1MZ–FE
A/TM
USA
11298–20340
RAV4
3S–FE (2WD/4WD)
All
USA
11298–7A620
3RZ–FE (2WD)
All
USA
11298–75550
3RZ–FE (4WD)
M/TM
USA
11298–75550
5VZ–FE (2WD/4WD)
All
USA
11298–62690
2RZ–FE (2WD)
All
USA
11298–75510
3RZ–FE (2WD/4WD)
A/TM
USA
11298–75530
M/TM
USA
11298–75530
A/TM
USA
11298–75550
A/TM
USA
11298–75530
All
USA
11298–62670
All
USA
11298–62690
5VZ–FE
All
CA
11298–62640
2UZ–FE
A/TM
USA
11298–50241
2UZ–FE
A/TM
USA
11298–50182
4Runner
Tacoma
3RZ–FE
(4WD XtraCab)
3RZ–FE
(4WD XtraCab)
3RZ–FE
(PreRunner)
5VZ–FE
(2WD XtraCab)
5VZ–FE
(4WD & PreRunner)
T ndra
Tundra
Land Cruiser
*
Page 6 of 6
CA = California Emission Specification, USA = 50 State Emission Specification
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABELS
Models:
All Models
May 4, 2001
Introduction
Replacement Certification Labels (vinyl label affixed to driver’s door or door post)
may be available from Toyota providing the request meets one of the criteria
listed below.
Certification Label Location
Applicable
Vehicles
Certification
Label Criteria
S All Toyota vehicles.
1. The vehicle is in an accident and the label is damaged or is attached to a part that will
be replaced during the repair.
NOTE:
S Processing a new label will be delayed significantly if the old certification label is
not available.
S A replacement label MAY NOT be available if the vehicle is more than 5 years old
and the old label does not accompany this request.
2. The label is stolen.
Procurement
Procedure
To request a replacement label, complete a copy of the form on the back of this bulletin.
Your dealer parts account will be billed $10.00 for each replacement of a damaged or
stolen label.
NOTE:
All replacement labels for damaged and/or stolen vehicles are subject to approval by
the Technical Compliance Department. If you have any specific questions, contact
(310) 468–3390.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG006-01
Title:
APPLICATION FOR REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABEL
REASON FOR REPLACEMENT
ACCIDENT DAMAGE
STOLEN
OTHER
REASON/EXPLANATION
ATTACH ORIGINAL LABEL HERE
PLEASE PROVIDE CORRECT VIN
NOTE:
Original label MUST accompany this application or order will be significantly delayed.
DEALER INFORMATION
DEALER CODE:
DEALER NAME:
ADDRESS:
STREET ADDRESS
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
TELEPHONE:
(
)
AREA CODE, TELEPHONE NUMBER
CONTACT:
FIRST NAME, LAST NAME
MAIL (DO NOT FAX) THE COMPLETED REQUEST FORM WITH THE OLD LABEL TO:
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A. INC.
TECHNICAL COMPLIANCE DEPARTMENT, S207
19001 S. WESTERN AVENUE
TORRANCE, CA 90509–2991
Technical Service
BULLETIN
September 26, 2003
Introduction
WARRANTY PARTS
MARKING PROCEDURE
Models:
All Models
Effective September 1, 2003, all warranty parts (as indicated on the next page) must be
marked in the area or location of the failure. The technician should complete this
procedure after the failed part has been removed from the vehicle and before the part is
placed in the 10–bin storage. (Exchanged parts and remanufactured parts are not
included in this procedure.)
Failed parts marking will be beneficial in detecting and resolving product and parts quality
issues. This will also offer additional opportunities to make future enhancements to our
parts and products.
Parts are subject to random inspection in the dealership by field representatives to
ensure compliance with this new policy.
Failure to comply with this policy may result in a debit of the corresponding
warranty claim(s).
Applicable
Vehicles
Parts
Marking
Procedure
S All models.
All technicians must follow these procedures to ensure proper parts marking:
S Wipe the part clean (no excess fluid should be present).
S Indicate area of defect or failure by marking the specific part(s) with a water
resistant permanent marker. Use a color that can be easily seen against the
background of the part being marked. For dark surfaces the color yellow is highly
recommended as well as the color black for light surfaces.
S Mark the area of failure or defect by drawing a circle, a square, pointing an arrow
or adhering tape with an indication of the failed or defect location.
S Attach a completed Warranty Parts Tag (M/N 00404–PRETN–TAGS) to the
marked part.
All other parts recovery/shipping policies and procedures apply.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG006–03
Title:
WARRANTY PARTS MARKING PROCEDURE – PG006-03
Parts
Marking
Requirement
Parts
Marking
List
Dealers are requested to mark the location of the failure of all warranty parts that are
listed below. This list is not inclusive. There may be other components that can be
marked in the area of failure. All other parts that can be marked should be marked.
assist grip assy
headlamps
audio (blemish)
headliner
back door garnish
hoses
bumper covers
instrument panel safety pad sub–assy
cargo cover (retractable)
Interior light assemblies and covers
carpet
knobs, levers, handles
clutch disc
l/pulley pump assy
clutch flywheel
mirrors (side and rearview)
combination meter glass
navigation or VES screens
console and components
pillar garnish
cowl assy
rack and pinion/power steering gear assy
cowl side trim sub–assy
radiator
cupholders
room partition board
cylinder head cover sub–assy
rotors (mark where min. runout is exceeded or warped)
dash panel insulator assy
seat covers/cushions
dashboard and trim
seat tracks
disc wheel
soft trim
display panels
spare tire cover
door handle assy
steering column cover
door moulding
steering wheel
door trim panel & molding
tail lamps and covers
emblems
transmission oil pan
engine oil pan
visor
exhaust manifold
washer jar
floor and cargo mats
wheel cap
gear shift knob
wheels
grills
Page 2 of 3
September 26, 2003
WARRANTY PARTS MARKING PROCEDURE – PG006-03
Parts
Marking
List
(Continued)
September 26, 2003
NOTE:
The following parts do not have to be marked unless the technician can determine
failure and location.
air induction/ejection systems
fuel injection systems
all computers
fuel injectors
alternators
fuel pump
audio (internal)
ignition system
batteries
internal engine components
bearings
internal transmission components
belts
oil cooler
catalytic converter
power door lock switches
crankshaft
remanufactured parts
cruise control
starters
distributors
suspension components
EGR systems
valve covers
engine control systems
window regulators
exchange parts
wiper motors
exhaust systems
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPLACEMENT VIN PLATES
Models:
All Models
May 4, 2001
Introduction
Replacement VIN plates (metal plates riveted to dashboard) may be available from
Toyota providing the request meets the criteria listed below.
VIN Plate Location
Applicable
Vehicles
Replacement
VIN Plate
Criteria
S All Toyota vehicles.
S The vehicle is in an accident and the plate is damaged.
NOTE:
The original plate to be replaced MUST accompany the request.
NOTE:
If a plate is stolen, be sure to contact the State Police or your State’s Department of
Motor Vehicles (DMV). In most cases the State DMV will issue a unique number so that
the original number can be included on stolen vehicle listings. If this is the case, a
replacement plate is NOT available from Toyota. However, the original VIN, NOT the
state issued VIN, must be used on all warranty claims.
Procurement
Procedure
To request a replacement plate, complete a copy of the form on the back of this page.
Note that the damaged VIN plate MUST accompany the request form. Your dealer parts
account will be billed $10.00 for each replacement of a damaged plate.
NOTE:
All replacement plates for damaged and/or stolen vehicles are subject to approval by
the Technical Compliance Department. If you have any specific questions, contact
(310) 468–3390.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG007-01
Title:
APPLICATION FOR REPLACEMENT VIN PLATE
REASON FOR REPLACEMENT
ACCIDENT DAMAGE
OTHER
REASON/EXPLANATION
PLEASE PROVIDE CORRECT VIN
ATTACH DAMAGED PLATE HERE
DEALER INFORMATION
DEALER CODE:
DEALER NAME:
ADDRESS:
STREET ADDRESS
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
TELEPHONE:
(
)
AREA CODE, TELEPHONE NUMBER
CONTACT:
FIRST NAME, LAST NAME
MAIL (DO NOT FAX) THE COMPLETED REQUEST FORM WITH THE OLD PLATE TO:
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A. INC.
TECHNICAL COMPLIANCE DEPARTMENT, S207
19001 S. WESTERN AVENUE
TORRANCE, CA. 90509–2991
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABELS
Models:
All Models
January 18, 2002
TSB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates PG006–01 dated May 4, 2001.
Revised text is red and underlined. The changes will take place February 1, 2002.
Introduction
Replacement Certification Labels (vinyl label affixed to driver’s door or door post)
may be available from Toyota providing the request meets one of the criteria
listed below.
Certification Label Location
MFD.BY:TOYOTA MOTOR MANUFACTURING
CANADA INC. 10/01
GVWR 3935LB GAWR FR 1970LB RR 1985LB
THIS VEHICLE CONFORMS TO ALL APPLICABLE
FEDERAL MOTOR VEHICLE SAFETY, BUMPER, AND
THEFT PREVENTION STANDARDS IN EFFECT ON
THE DATE OF MANUFACTURE SHOWN ABOVE.
XT0XX00X0X000000
PASS.CAR
C/TR:3L5/FB14 MODEL:ZZE134L – DHPNKA
A/TM:–04A/U341F MADE IN CANADA
S26 AA01904759
Applicable
Vehicles
Certification
Label Criteria
S All Toyota vehicles.
1. The vehicle is in an accident and the label is damaged or is attached to a part that will
be replaced during the repair.
NOTE:
S Processing a new label will be delayed significantly if the original certification label
is not available.
S A replacement label MAY NOT be available if the vehicle is more than 5 years old
and the old label does not accompany this request.
2. The label is stolen.
Procurement
Procedure
To request a replacement label, complete a copy of the form on the back of this bulletin.
Your dealer parts account will be billed $25.00 for each replacement of a damaged or
stolen label.
NOTE:
All replacement labels for damaged and/or stolen vehicles are subject to approval by
the Technical Compliance Department. If you have any specific questions, contact
(310) 468–3390.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG008-02
Title:
APPLICATION FOR REPLACEMENT CERTIFICATION LABEL
REASON FOR REPLACEMENT
ACCIDENT DAMAGE
STOLEN
OTHER
MFD.BY: TOYOTAMOTOR MANUFACTURING
CANADA INC. 10/01
GVWR3935LBGAWRFR1970LBRR1985LB
THISVEHICLECONFORMSTOALLAPPLICABLE
FEDERALMOTORVEHICLESAFETY, BUMPER, AND
THEFTPREVENTIONSTANDARDS IN EFFECT ON
THE DATEOFMANUFACTURESHOWNABOVE.
XT0XX00X0X000000 PASS.CAR
C/TR:3L5/FB14MODEL:ZZE134L–DHPNKA
A/TM:–04A/U341FMADEINCANADA
S26AA01904759
REASON/EXPLANATION
ATTACH ORIGINAL LABEL HERE
PLEASE PROVIDE CORRECT VIN
NOTE:
Original label MUST accompany this application or order will be significantly delayed.
DEALER INFORMATION
DEALER CODE:
DEALER NAME:
ADDRESS:
STREET ADDRESS
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
TELEPHONE:
(
)
AREA CODE, TELEPHONE NUMBER
CONTACT:
FIRST NAME, LAST NAME
MAIL (DO NOT FAX) THE COMPLETED REQUEST FORM WITH THE OLD LABEL TO:
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A. INC.
TECHNICAL COMPLIANCE DEPARTMENT, S207
19001 S. WESTERN AVENUE
TORRANCE, CA 90509–2991
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REPLACEMENT VIN PLATES
Models:
All Models
January 18, 2002
TSB UPDATE NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates PG007–01 dated May 4, 2001.
Revised text is red and underlined. The changes will take place February 1, 2002.
Introduction
Replacement VIN plates (metal plates riveted to dashboard) may be available from
Toyota providing the request meets the criteria listed below.
VIN Plate Location
Applicable
Vehicles
Replacement
VIN Plate
Criteria
S All Toyota vehicles.
S The vehicle is in an accident and the plate is damaged.
NOTE:
The original plate to be replaced MUST accompany the request.
NOTE:
If a plate is stolen, be sure to contact the State Police or your State’s Department of
Motor Vehicles (DMV). In most cases the State DMV will issue a unique number so that
the original number can be included on stolen vehicle listings. If this is the case, a
replacement plate is NOT available from Toyota. However, the original VIN, NOT the
state issued VIN, must be used on all warranty claims.
Procurement
Procedure
To request a replacement plate, complete a copy of the form on the back of this page.
Note that the damaged VIN plate MUST accompany the request form. Your dealer parts
account will be billed $25.00 for each replacement of a damaged plate.
NOTE:
All replacement plates for damaged and/or stolen vehicles are subject to approval by
the Technical Compliance Department. If you have any specific questions, contact
(310) 468–3390.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG009-02
Title:
APPLICATION FOR REPLACEMENT VIN PLATE
REASON FOR REPLACEMENT
ACCIDENT DAMAGE
OTHER
REASON/EXPLANATION
PLEASE PROVIDE CORRECT VIN
ATTACH DAMAGED PLATE HERE
DEALER INFORMATION
DEALER CODE:
DEALER NAME:
ADDRESS:
STREET ADDRESS
CITY, STATE, ZIP CODE
TELEPHONE:
(
)
AREA CODE, TELEPHONE NUMBER
CONTACT:
FIRST NAME, LAST NAME
MAIL (DO NOT FAX) THE COMPLETED REQUEST FORM WITH THE OLD PLATE TO:
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A. INC.
TECHNICAL COMPLIANCE DEPARTMENT, S207
19001 S. WESTERN AVENUE
TORRANCE, CA. 90509–2991
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SUSPENSION BALL JOINT INSPECTION
Models:
See Applicable Models
December 4, 2002
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
This bulletin describes the inspection method and free play specification figures for
suspension ball joints. The on–vehicle inspection methods have been standardized.
S 1989 – 1992 model year Cressida vehicles.
S 1989 – 1998 model year Supra vehicles.
S 2001 – 2003 model year Highlander vehicles.
S 1995 – 2003 model year Avalon vehicles.
S 1989 – 2003 model year Camry / Camry Solara vehicles.
S 1985 – 2003 model year MR2 vehicles.
S 1990 – 2003 model year Celica vehicles.
S 2001 – 2003 model year Prius vehicles.
S 1988 – 2003 model year Corolla / Corolla Matrix vehicles.
S 2000 – 2003 model year ECHO vehicles.
S 1991– 1999 model year Tercel vehicles.
S 1991 – 1999 model year Paseo vehicles.
S 1990 – 1997 model year Previa vehicles.
S 1998 – 2003 model year Sienna vehicles.
S 1996 – 2003 model year RAV4 / RAV4 EV vehicles.
S 1999 – 2003 model year Land Cruiser vehicles.
S 2001 – 2003 model year Sequoia vehicles.
S 1989 – 2003 model year 4Runner vehicles.
S 2000 – 2003 model year Tundra vehicles.
S 1995 – 2003 model year Tacoma vehicles.
S 1989 – 1995 model year Truck vehicles.
S 1993 – 1998 model year T–100 vehicles.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 8
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG027-02
Title:
SUSPENSION BALL JOINT INSPECTION – PG027-02
Inspection
Information
LOWER BALL JOINT OR SUSPENSION
BALL JOINT
MODEL
Cressida
(MX8#)
1989 – 1992
LOCATION
Supra
(JZA80)
1994 – 1998
UPPER BALL JOINT
INSP.
METHOD
MAX. PLAY
TURNING
TORQUE
INSP.
METHOD
MAX. PLAY
TURNING
TORQUE
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Rear
3
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
Front
1–(A)
0.4 mm
4 in.Slbf
(0.5 Nm)
or Less
2 (A)
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5
(3
5 NSm)
or Less
2 (A)
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5
(3
5 NSm)
or Less
Su ra (MA70)
Supra
1989 – 1994
Page 2 of 8
December 4, 2002
Rear
3
No Play
Felt
Front
1–(A)
0.4 mm
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
27 in.Slbf
(3.0 NSm)
or Less
Rear
1–(A)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
Highlander
(ACU2#,
MCU2#)
2001 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Avalon
(MCX10, 20)
1995 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Camry,
Camry Solara
(SV2#,
VZV21,
VCV10,
MCV10, 20,
30
ACV 20, 30
SVX 10, 20)
1989 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
SUSPENSION BALL JOINT INSPECTION – PG027-02
Inspection
Information
(Continued)
December 4, 2002
LOWER BALL JOINT OR SUSPENSION
BALL JOINT
MODEL
LOCATION
Front
MR2
(AW1#)
1985 – 1989
MR2
(SW2#)
1990 – 1996
MR2
(ZZW30)
2000 – 2003
Rear
INSP.
METHOD
MAX. PLAY
TURNING
TORQUE
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
27 in.Slbf
(3.0 NSm)
or Less
No Play
Felt
27 in.Slbf
(3.0 NSm)
or Less*1
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less*2
1–(C)*1
3*2
Front
1 (C)
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
Rear
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
UPPER BALL JOINT
INSP.
METHOD
MAX. PLAY
TURNING
TORQUE
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
22 in.Slbf
(2.5 NSm)
or Less
27 in.Slbf
(3.0 NSm)
or Less
22 in.Slbf
(2.5 NSm)
or Less
9 in.Slbf
(1.0 NSm)
or Less
Rear
3
Celica
(AT180,
ST18#)
1990 – 1993
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
35 in.Slbf
(4.0 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Celica
(AT200,
ST20#,
ZZT23#)
1994 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
44 in.Slbf
(5.0 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Prius
(NHW11)
2001 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
44 in.Slbf
(5.0 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Corolla
(AE9#, 10#)
1988 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
27 in.Slbf
(3.0 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Corolla/
Corolla Matrix
(AE10#,
ZZE11#, 13#)
1988 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
44 in.Slbf
(5.0 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
ECHO
(NCP1#)
2000 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Tercel, Paseo
(EL4#, 5#)
1991 – 1999
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
27 in.Slbf
(3.0 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Page 3 of 8
SUSPENSION BALL JOINT INSPECTION – PG027-02
Inspection
Information
(Continued)
LOWER BALL JOINT OR SUSPENSION
BALL JOINT
MODEL
LOCATION
UPPER BALL JOINT
INSP.
METHOD
MAX. PLAY
TURNING
TORQUE
INSP.
METHOD
MAX. PLAY
TURNING
TORQUE
Previa
(TCR1#, 2#)
1990 – 1997
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
35 in.Slbf
(4.0 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Sienna
(MCL10)
1998 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
Rear
3
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
N/A
No Play
Felt
RAV4
(ACA2#)
2001 – 2003
Front
1–(C)
No Play
Felt
44 in.Slbf
(5.0 NSm)
or Less
N/A
N/A
N/A
Land Cruiser
100
(UZJ100)
1999 – 2003
Front
1–(A)
No Play
Felt
27 in.Slbf
(3.0 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
Sequoia
(UCK35, 45)
2001 – 2003
Front
1–(A)
0.5 mm
22 in.Slbf
(2.5 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
4Runner
(VZN120,
13#, RN13#,
12#)
1989 – 1995
Front
1–(C)
2.3 mm
53 in.Slbf
(6.0 NSm)
or Less
2–(B)
No Play
Felt
Turns
Smoothly
4Runner
(RZN18#,
VZN18#)
1996 – 2003
Front
1–(A)
0.5 mm
22 in.Slbf
(2.5 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
Tundra
(VCK30, 40,
UCK30, 40)
2000 – 2003
Front
1–(A)
0.5 mm
22 in.Slbf
(2.5 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
RAV4/
RAV4 EV
(SXA1#
(SXA1#,
BEA11)
1996 – 2000
Page 4 of 8
December 4, 2002
SUSPENSION BALL JOINT INSPECTION – PG027-02
Inspection
Information
(Continued)
December 4, 2002
LOWER BALL JOINT OR SUSPENSION
BALL JOINT
MODEL
LOCATION
UPPER BALL JOINT
INSP.
METHOD
MAX. PLAY
TURNING
TORQUE
INSP.
METHOD
MAX. PLAY
TURNING
TORQUE
Tacoma*3
(RZN140,
150, VZN150)
1995 – 2003
Front
1–(A)
0.5 mm
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
Tacoma*4
(RZN140,
150, VZN150)
1995 – 2003
Front
1–(A)
0.5 mm
31 in.Slbf
(3.5 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
Tacoma
(RZN161,
171, 19#,
VZN160, 170,
195)
1995 – 2003
Front
1–(A)
0.5 mm
22 in.Slbf
(2.5 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
No Play
Felt
40 in.Slbf
(4.5 NSm)
or Less
Truck*5
(RN8#, 90
VZN85, 9#)
1989 – 1995
Front
1–(B)
2.3 mm
44 in.Slbf
(5.0 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
2.3 mm
35 in.Slbf
(4.0 NSm)
or Less
Truck*6
(RN8#, 90
VZN85, 9#)
1989 – 1995
Front
1–(B)
0.5 mm
44 in.Slbf
(5.0 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
2.3 mm
35 in.Slbf
(4.0 NSm)
or Less
Truck
(RN10#, 11#
VZN10#, 110)
1989 – 1995
Front
1–(C)
2.3 mm
53 in.Slbf
(6.0 NSm)
or Less
2–(B)
2.3 mm
Turns
Smoothly
T–100
(RCK10,
VCK1#)
1993 – 1998
Front
1–(A)
0.5 mm
62 in.Slbf
(7.0 NSm)
or Less
2–(A)
1.9 mm
35 in.Slbf
(4.0 NSm)
or Less
T–100
(VCK2#)
1993 – 1998
Front
1–(C)
2.3 mm
53 in.Slbf
(6.0 NSm)
or Less
2–(B)
No Play
Felt (from
1995 MY)
Turns
Smoothly
*1 Lower Ball Joint
*2 Suspension Arm Ball Joint
*3 With Serial Number Prior to Z718190
*4 With Serial Number After and including Z718190
*5 With Serial Number Prior to those listed in *6
*6 RN80–0087125, RN80–5130170, RN85–0004477, RN85–5046258, RN85–9010725, RN90–0014600,
RN90–5047105, RN90–9002376, VZN85–0003605, VZN85–5004547, VZN90–5025989, VZN95–0025290,
VZN90–0006119
Page 5 of 8
SUSPENSION BALL JOINT INSPECTION – PG027-02
On–Vehicle
Inspection
NOTE:
S Be sure to check the table for the
applicable inspection type based on
the vehicle model.
S Refer to the table for the standard
free play values.
1. Inspect Lower Ball Joint Free Play
A. Move the hub up and down by
hand (most models with wishbone
suspension):
a. Remove the tire.
b. Install the 2 lug nuts.
c. Inspect the free play while
moving the lug nuts up and
down at a force of 67 lbf
(294 N, 30 kgf).
B. Move the lower arm using a lever
(some models with double
wishbone type suspension):
a. Lift up the vehicle.
b. Place the tip of the lever to the
wheel and inspect the free
play while moving the lower
arm up and down.
C. Move the lower arm by hand (all
models with strut type suspension
and some models with wishbone
type suspension):
a. Lift up the vehicle.
b. Inspect the free play while
moving the lower arm up and
down at a force of 67 lbf
(294 N, 30 kgf).
Page 6 of 8
December 4, 2002
SUSPENSION BALL JOINT INSPECTION – PG027-02
On–Vehicle
Inspection
(Continued)
December 4, 2002
2. Inspect Upper Ball Joint Free Play
A. Move the upper arm by hand
(models with the LOWER control
arm linked by a torsion bar, and
all models using a coil spring).
a. Remove the front tire.
b. Inspect the free play while
moving the upper arm up and
down at a force of 67 lbf
(294 N, 30 kgf).
B. Move the tire with a lever (models
with the UPPER control arm
linked by a torsion bar).
a. Lift up the vehicle.
b. Place the lever under the tire,
and inspect the free play while
lifting the tire using a wooden
stick, etc., as a fulcrum.
3. Inspect the Suspension Arm Ball
Joint Free Play
A. Lift up the vehicle.
B. Inspect the free play while moving
the control arm by hand.
(Reference)
Free Play Inspection Method
(Gauge Installation)
S Position the dial gauge between the
arm (upper or lower) and the knuckle,
and measure free play.
(This illustration shows how to
measure free play for vehicles with
double wishbone type suspension
with coil spring.)
4. Inspect Ball Joint Dust Cover
Check for cracks and grease leaks on
the dust cover (boots).
Page 7 of 8
SUSPENSION BALL JOINT INSPECTION – PG027-02
Turning
Torque
Inspection
Inspect Ball Joint Turning Torque
Move the stud back and forth 5 times,
and then turn the stud continuously at
3–5 seconds per turn, and measure the
turning torque at the 5th turn.
HINT:
Refer to the table for standard values
for the turning torque.
Page 8 of 8
December 4, 2002
Technical Service
BULLETIN
YEAR 2000 READINESS DISCLOSURE
Models:
All Models
December 24, 1999
Introduction
Based upon information we have obtained from our suppliers,1 all factory–installed
systems in Toyota cars, sports utility vehicles and trucks distributed and/or sold by Toyota
(“Vehicles”)2 will not be affected by the change of date from 1999 to the year 2000.
Toyota anticipates no problems with past, current or future Toyota brand vehicles or
Genuine Toyota parts and accessories regarding year 2000 readiness. We hope the
following information is helpful to you.
Please contact our Customer Service Department at 1–800–331–4331 should you have
any other questions.
S All Models
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
WARRANTY STATEMENT WITH RESPECT TO TOYOTA BRAND VEHICLES
Toyota is pleased to confirm that the manufacturer’s limited express warranty and
Toyota’s powertrain warranty warrant that all factory–installed systems in new Vehicles
and Toyota Certified Used Vehicles shall be free of any defect arising solely due to a
change in date from the year 1999 to the year 2000.3
With respect to Vehicles no longer covered under such Toyota limited express warranty,
Toyota is not aware of any operational safety or functional impact the year 2000 date
change would have upon any factory–installed system in Toyota Vehicles. Should Toyota
become aware of any material impact to the operational safety or functionality of such
systems, Toyota shall publish such information promptly.
WARRANTY STATEMENT WITH RESPECT TO GENUINE TOYOTA PARTS AND
ACCESSORIES
Toyota is pleased to confirm that the manufacturer’s limited express warranty warrants
that all new Toyota Genuine Parts and Accessories shall be free of any defect arising
solely due to a change in date from the year 1999 to the year 2000. 3
With respect to products no longer covered under a Toyota limited express warranty,
Toyota is not aware of any operational safety or functional impact the year 2000 date
change would have upon such products. Should Toyota become aware of any material
impact to the operational safety or functionality of such a product, Toyota shall publish
such information promptly.
1
2
3
Toyota relies on the statements made by its suppliers and has not independently verified such information.
Vehicles includes alternative fuel vehicles.
Please refer to terms of limited express warranty for disclaimers, limitations and restrictions.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
PG032–99
Title:
YEAR 2000 READINESS DISCLOSURE – PG032-99
Parts &
Accessories
December 24, 1999
GENUINE TOYOTA PARTS AND ACCESSORIES
Based upon information we have obtained from our suppliers,1 all new Genuine Toyota
Parts and Accessories will not be affected by the change of date from 1999 to the year
2000.
DEALER–INSTALLED AND OTHER THIRD PARTY–INSTALLED SYSTEMS/
PRODUCTS
Our dealers and distributors may sell and/or install products that are not Genuine Toyota
Parts and Accessories. Toyota can only determine the Year 2000 readiness status of
Genuine Toyota Parts and Accessories. Therefore, the above statements do not apply to
products that are not Genuine Toyota Parts and Accessories or were not installed by the
factory. We encourage you to contact your dealer or other relevant third party regarding
products installed on your Toyota vehicle(s) that are not Genuine Toyota Parts and
Accessories and/or were not installed by the factory to determine any Year 2000 issues
associated with those products.
1
Page 2 of 2
Toyota relies on the statements made by its suppliers and has not independently verified such information.
April 9, 1999
Introduction
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE
UTILITY
Models:
’98 & ’99 Avalon, Camry, Land Cruiser & Sienna
’99 Solara & 4Runner
The Diagnostic Tester now incorporates a Key Code Utility Menu capable of performing
the following tasks for immobilizer functions:
S Key Code Registration
S Key Code Erasure
S Auto–Registration Closure
The information contained in this bulletin will provide you with a detailed outline for the
use of immobilizer functions with the Diagnostic Tester.
Affected
Vehicles
S 1998 Avalon, Camry, Land Cruiser and Sienna.
S 1998 Avalon, Camry, Land Cruiser, Sienna, Solara and 4Runner.
Parts
Information
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
01001271
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit
01001895–005
6.0a Diagnostic Software Card
NOTE:
Replacement Diagnostic Tester Kits or Software Cards may be ordered by calling
OTC at 1–800–933–8335.
Function
Description
(Key Code
Utility)
Key Registration
This function allows the registration of additional key codes for transponder keys
(Master/Sub Keys) using a Registered Master Key.
Key Code Erasure
This function allows the user to erase all the key codes for transponder keys except
the Registered Master Key used during this function.
Auto Registration Closure
This function allows the user to close “Auto Registration Mode“ when less than three
keys have been registered.
NOTE:
When a new ECU is installed, it is in the “Auto Registration Mode” from the factory.
This allows Transponder Keys to automatically register as they are inserted into the
Ignition Cylinder. After three Transponder Keys are registered, the ECU closes “Auto
Registration Mode”. See the Repair Manual for further details.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 9
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
Technical Service
BULLETIN
SS001–99
Title:
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY – SS001–99
April 9, 1999
Operation
Procedures
This section provides the procedures necessary to access the IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE
UTILITY functions. Refer to the instructions below.
Verify
Immobilizer
Key Type
Before any IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY function can be performed, the type of
Transponder Key must be verified. The following steps show how to verify the
Transponder Key type.
1. Connect the Diagnostic Tester to DLC3 and press the (ON) key.
2. Insert a Registered Master Key (Black Key Head) into the ignition key cylinder and
turn to the ON position.
HINT:
A Registered Master Key is required for KEY REGISTRATION, KEY CODE ERASURE,
and AUTO REGISTRATION CLOSURE. A Sub Key (Grey Key Head) will not perform
these functions.
3. “From the “FUNCTION SELECT” menu
(Screen A), select [1: OBD/MOBD].
4. From the “OBD/MOBD MENU“ (Screen
B), select [6: IMMOBILIZER].
5. From the “DIAGNOSTIC MENU
IMMOBILIZER” (Screen C), select [1:
CURRENT DATA]
Page 2 of 9
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY – SS001–99
Verify
Immobilizer
Key Type
(Continued)
April 9, 1999
6. From the “CURRENT DATA MENU
IMMOBILIZER” (Screen D), select [1:
DATA LIST].
7. From the “SELECT DATA“ menu
(Screen E), select [ALL].
8. The Transponder Key Type in the ignition
cylinder will be displayed (Screen F).
[MASTER] =
[SUB]
=
[NO]
=
Registered Master Key
Registered Sub Key
Not a Registered Key,
or Vehicle is not
equipped with
Immobilizer.
NOTE:
If the Transponder Key is a Master Key, proceed to [4: KEY CODE UTILITY] by
pressing the (EXIT) key back to the “DIAGNOSTIC MENU IMMOBILIZER“ (Screen C).
From the “DIAGNOSTIC MENU IMMOBILIZER“ (Screen C), select [4: KEY CODE
UTILITY]
Page 3 of 9
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY – SS001–99
April 9, 1999
Verify
Immobilizer
Key Type
(Continued)
9. From the “KEY CODE UTILITY” menu
(Screen G), the functions listed are
outlined in the next sections.
Key
Registration
This function allows the registration of additional Key Codes for Transponder Keys
(Master/Sub Keys) using a Registered Master Key. The following screens show how to
perform Key Registration.
NOTE:
This function requires the use of one Registered Master Key. The use of a Sub Key
will NOT complete Key Registration.
1. From the “KEY CODE UTILITY“ menu
(Screen A), select [1: KEY
REGISTRATION].
2. Confirm the instruction on Screen B
and press the (ENTER) key.
Page 4 of 9
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY – SS001–99
April 9, 1999
3. From the “KEY SELECTION” menu
(Screen C), select the Transponder
Key type to be registered and press
the (ENTER) key.
NOTE:
Do not register a SUB KEY as a
MASTER KEY. The SUB KEY is
typically left with an attendant when
the vehicle is parked. A Registered
Master Key allows the user to
add/erase transponder keys.
4. From “KEY SELECTION” (Screen D),
confirm the type of Transponder Key
to be registered and press the
(ENTER) key.
5. After pressing the (YES) key, remove
the Registered Master Key from the
Ignition Cylinder within 20 seconds.
After removing the key, press the
(ENTER) key.
6. Insert the New Transponder Key into
the Ignition Cylinder within 10
seconds and press the (ENTER) key.
HINT:
Look at the Security Indicator Light. It
will begin to flash as the New
Transponder Key is inserted.
Page 5 of 9
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY – SS001–99
Key
Registration
(Continued)
April 9, 1999
7. The registration of the New
Transponder Key will be completed in
approximately 60 seconds.
HINT:
The Security Indicator continues to
flash during registration.
8. Screen H will be shown at completion
of registration. Confirm the Security
Indicator turns OFF and press the
(ENTER) key.
HINT:
The Security Indicator will stop
flashing when Key Registration is
complete.
9. Insert the New Registered Master Key
into the Ignition Cylinder and turn to
the ON position and press the
(ENTER) key.
Key Code
Erasure
This function allows the user to erase all the Key Codes for Transponder Keys except the
Registered Master Key used during this function. The following screens show how to
perform Key Code Erasure.
HINT:
This function requires the use of one Registered Master Key. The use of a Sub Key
will NOT complete Key Code Erasure.
Page 6 of 9
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY – SS001–99
Key Code
Erasure
(Continued)
April 9, 1999
1. From the “KEY CODE UTILITY“ menu
(Screen A), select [2: KEY CODE
ERASURE].
2. Confirm the instruction on Screen B
and press the (ENTER) key.
3. Confirm the instruction on Screen C
and press the (YES) key.
NOTE:
By pressing the (YES) key, all
Transponder Key Codes will be erased
except the Registered Master Key in
the Ignition Cylinder.
HINT:
After pressing the (YES) key, the
Security Indicator will start to flash.
4. Pull out the Registered Master Key
from the Ignition Cylinder within 10
seconds (Screen D).
HINT:
Security Indicator continues to flash.
Page 7 of 9
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY – SS001–99
Key Code
Erasure
(Continued)
April 9, 1999
5. If Step 4 was completed correctly,
Screen E will confirm ERASURE was
sucessful.
HINT:
If the Erasure completed, the security
indicator should still be blinking.
6. Insert the Registered Master Key into
the Ignition Cylinder and turn to the
ON position and press the (ENTER)
key.
HINT:
Look at the Security Indicator Light.
Inserting a Registered Master Key
causes the Security Indicator to
immediately stop blinking.
Auto
Registration
Closure
This function allows the user to close Auto Registration Mode when less than three keys
have been registered.
NOTE:
When a New ECU is installed, it is in the Auto Registration Mode. This mode allows
the Transponder Keys to automatically register as they are inserted into the Ignition
Cylinder. See the Repair Manual for further details.
CAUTION:
This function requires the use of one Registered Master Key. The use of a Sub Key
will NOT complete Auto Registration Closure. The use of a non–transponder key
during this function may damage the ECU.
1. From the “KEY CODE UTILITY“ menu
(Screen A), select [3: AUTO REG
CLOSURE].
Page 8 of 9
SCANTOOL IMMOBILIZER KEY CODE UTILITY – SS001–99
Auto
Registration
Closure
(Continued)
April 9, 1999
2. Confirm the instruction on Screen B
and press the (ENTER) key.
3. At “AUTO REGIST. CLOSURE”
(Screen C), the Auto Registration
Closure Information will be displayed.
Press the (ENTER) key to finish.
Page 9 of 9
September 8, 2003
Introduction
SS001-03
Technical Service
BULLETIN
DIAGNOSTIC TESTER CONTROLLER
AREA NETWORK (CAN) INTERFACE
MODULE
Models:
All Models
Over the next four model years, all Toyota vehicles will begin using an all–new diagnostic
communication protocol, Controller Area Network (CAN). CAN will be introduced on the
2004 Prius this fall. A CAN Interface Module has been distributed to all dealers as an
essential Special Service Tool (SST) and will allow the Diagnostic Tester to communicate
with CAN–equipped vehicles. Please use the following instructions to install the new CAN
Interface Module as soon as it arrives at your dealership.
NOTE:
S Version 10.2a or later Diagnostic Tester Software must be used to enable
communication with CAN–equipped vehicles. Version 10.2a will be distributed to
dealers via TIS before CAN–equipped vehicles arrive at dealers.
S There is no need to remove the CAN Interface Module when working with non–CAN
systems or older software versions (Version 10.1a or earlier). The Diagnostic Tester
will communicate with all DLC3/J1962 based systems with the CAN Interface
Module installed.
S All Models
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
SSTs
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
01001271
1
01002744
1
01002593-005
1
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit*
CAN Interface Module Kit*
12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
with version 10.2a Software (or later)*
*
Essential SSTs.
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, CAN Interface Modules, Program Cards or SSTs may
be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
Title:
DIAGNOSTIC TESTER CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (CAN) INTERFACE – SS001-03
September 8, 2003
Installation
Procedure
Program Card With Version
10.2a (or Later) Software
DLC Cable
(P/N 02001637)
CAN Interface Module Kit
(P/N 01002744)
Vehicle Interface
Module (VIM)
DLC1
(Check Connector)
Cable
Black
Grey
CAN Interface Module
DLC2
(TDCL)
Cable
CAN Interface Module Is Used for
ALL DLC3/J1962 Communication
The Original DLC3 (OBDII
Connector P/N 02001643)
Cable Is No Longer Used.
1. Remove the original DLC3 Cable and store it in the Diagnostic Tester storage case.
2. Connect the CAN Interface Module to the DLC Cable.
3. Use the Diagnostic Tester with the CAN Module installed for all DLC3/J1962 based
vehicle communication.
4. If you experience problems with the Diagnostic Tester or CAN Interface Module,
please contact Toyota Special Service Tool Customer Support at 1–800–933–8335.
NOTE:
S There is no need to remove the CAN Interface Module when working with non–CAN
systems or older software versions (Version 10.1a or earlier). The Diagnostic Tester
will communicate with all DLC3/J1962 based systems with the CAN Interface
Module installed.
S For DLC1 and DLC2 communication you must continue to use the Vehicle Interface
Module (VIM).
Page 2 of 2
SPECIAL
SERVICE TOOLS
SS94-002
AUGUST 12, 1994
ALL MODELS
WIRE HARNESS REPAIR KIT “B”
Page 1 of 2
The new Wire Harness Repair Kit “B” has been released as an essential Special Service Tool (SST)
to supplement the original Wire Harness Repair Kit. This kit holds an initial supply of 21 new type
electrical terminals and connectors as well as the necessary supplies and small tools for most electrical repairs.
The Wire Harness Repair Kit manual has been updated and now contains an illustrated catalog of
all terminals and connectors available for Toyota vehicles. Connector Replacement Guidelines, a
Connector/Terminal Usage Guide, and a Connector Quick Reference Chart have been added as
additional reference. This manual is the only reference available which provides information on
properly identifying connectors and terminals.
When components/supplies need to be replaced, refer to page 21 in the manual or the reverse side
of this TSB. Note: The manual is no longer available through the Toyota Non-Parts System. It is
available separately under part number 410094 by calling OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES U.S.A., INC.
Page 2 of 2
WIRE HARNESS REPAIR KIT “B”
PARTS REPLACEMENT ORDERING INFORMATION:
The following parts can be ordered through Toyota Motor Sales on a normal parts order:
Part Number
Description
Part Number
Description
82998-12010
82998-12030
82998-12050
82998-12070
82998-12090
82998-12110
82998-12130
82998-12150
82998-12170
82998-12190
82998-12210
82998-12230
82998-12250
82998-12270
82998-12290
82998-12310
82998-12330
82998-12350
82998-12370
82998-12390
82998-12410
82998-12430
82998-12450
216824
00204-34130
00204-34137
00204-34138
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Repair Splice
Silicon Tape
18/22 Splice
14/16 Splice
10/12 Splice
82998-12470
82998-12490
82998-12020
82998-12040
82998-12060
82998-12080
82998-12100
82998-12120
82998-12140
82998-12160
82998-12180
82998-12200
82998-12220
82998-12240
82998-12260
82998-12280
82998-12300
82998-12320
82998-12340
82998-12360
82998-12380
82998-12400
82998-12420
82998-12440
82998-12460
82998-12480
82998-12500
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Repair
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
Splice
The following parts can be ordered from OTC Tool & Equipment Division, SPX Corporation, 655
Eisenhower Drive, Owatonna, Minnesota 55060:
Part Number
Description
Part Number
Description
62164
62166
310031
Tool Box Kit A
(Toyota)
Tool Box Kit B
(Toyota)
Tool Box (Lexus)
Crimper (Kit A)
310032
310033
216820
216822
00002-217681
00002-217958
Wire Stripper
Terminal Pick
Terminal Gauge
Terminal Gauge
Terminal Pick
Terminal Pick
AMP47100-1
Crimper (Kit B)
410094
Repair Manual
310044
All remaining parts can be purchased from a local supplier.
Models:
All Models
September 26, 1997
Introduction
Parts
Information
When inspecting or making brake booster push rod adjustments with SST 09737–00010,
it is necessary to assure proper tool configuration prior to use. The SST has a reversible
center plunger that allows it to function on a wide range of Toyota vehicles. Prior to using,
verify that it is configured correctly for the application by checking the master cylinder
outer diameter at the point illustrated below. The dimensions for the SST, Part Number
09737–00010, are also shown in the illustrations below.
PART NUMBER
09737–00010
Warranty
Information
PART NAME
Brake Booster Push Rod Gauge (SST)
OPCODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not applicable to warranty
–
–
–
–
Page 1 of 1
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
TSB
BRAKE BOOSTER PUSH ROD GAUGE (SST)
SS002–97
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
1999 SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
Models:
All ’98 & ’99 Models
July 9, 1999
Introduction
This TSB contains information regarding Special Service Tools (SSTs) distributed or
added to the SST program during 1999 model year. Both the Essential and Available
SSTs are listed by tool number, tool name, and model application.
Special Service Tools can be ordered through the Toyota SST Program by calling
1–800–933–8335.
Applicable
Vehicles
1999 Essential
Special Service
Tools
S All 1998 and 1999 MY Toyota Vehicles.
1999 ESSENTIAL SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
TOOL NUMBER
09521–25021–1
09631–12090
09710–28012–01
02002–02XXX
TOOL NAME
APPLICATION
Rear Axle Shaft Puller Attachment
Land Cruiser
Seal Ring Tool
Land Cruiser
Front Suspension Bushing Tool Set
Land Cruiser
Haweka Flange Plate
Land Cruiser
Note: XXX is Spindle Shaft Size
09950–60030–01
Replacer Set #3
09999–00310
Toyota Spare Tire Lock Kit
09999–00305
Spare Tire Lock Adapter
Part of Kit #
09999–00310
(Toyota/Lexus Dual Dealers)
09268–21010–01
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Fuel Hose Puller
Land Cruiser
Land Cruiser,
T100, Tacoma
T100
Corolla (’99)
Page 1 of 2
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS002–99
Title:
1999 SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS – SS002-99
1999 Essential
Special Service
Tools (Cont’d)
1999 Available
Special Service
Tools
July 9, 1999
1999 ESSENTIAL SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
TOOL NUMBER
01001895–U05
TOOL NAME
ScanTool Software
(Annual Reprogramming &
Site License)
APPLICATION
All Models
1999 ESSENTIAL SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
TOOL NUMBER
09710–01031
TOOL NAME
Upper Arm Bushing Replacer (Part of Set)
APPLICATION
RAV4
Part of Kit #
09710–22021
09710–22021
Upper Arm Bushing Replacer Set
TOY280341
Rivet Nut Tool
All Models
TOY280087
Homelink Tester
All Models
00002–MLR6872A Evap Tester
Page 2 of 2
Land Cruiser
’99 MY with
EVAP
Service Port
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER
SOFTWARE UPDATE
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
All Models & Model Years Through Current
June 7, 2002
Introduction
The internal software of the Midtronics Battery Tester can now be periodically updated to
support future models. New updates will include new battery warranty codes and testing
information.
The Technical Information System (TIS) will be the primary distribution method for battery
tester software updates. Utilizing the new Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW) and the new
essential SST (Midtronics Battery Tester Adapter), you will be able to quickly and easily
update your Midtronics Battery Tester.
This bulletin will show you how to use and install the Midtronics Update Wizard to update
the Midtronics tester software.
S All models and model years through current.
Applicable
Vehicles
Required
Tools &
Material
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
Midtronics Battery Tester*
Midtronics Battery Tester Adapter*
*
Warranty
Information
Process
Overview
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
00002–MP815–T
1
00002–DMPUC
1
Essential SSTs.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
The Midtronics Battery Tester Software Update is a 2-step process:
1. Installing the Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW).
The Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW) is an application that only needs to be installed
on the PC one time. This bulletin will provide the steps to install the MUW.
2. Using the Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW).
The Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW) will be used with each battery tester software
update. The Update Wizard will walk you through each step to connect the PC to the
tester and perform the update.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 10
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS002-02
Title:
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure:
Preparation
June 7, 2002
Before Installation or Use of the Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW):
Steps A and B are required to begin the update process. (Refer to Figure 1.)
A. Open TIS (Technical Information System) and go to the “Diagnostics” section.
B. Click on the text “Midtronics Battery Tester Software.”
FIGURE 1.
B
A
Page 2 of 10
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure
June 7, 2002
1. Installing the Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW).
NOTE:
The Midtronics Update Wizard only needs to be installed once and must be installed
before the rest of the update process can take place. If this step is already complete,
continue on to step 2.
A. Click on the text “Install MUW.” (Figure 2.)
B. The file download window will appear. Click on “Run this program from it’s current
location.”
C. Click the “OK” button.
D. Allow the Update Wizard to perform its self–installation. This will take only a few
minutes.
FIGURE 2.
A
B
C
Page 3 of 10
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 7, 2002
2. Using the Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW).
A. Click on the latest version of production software. (Figure 3.) This will begin the
software update process.
B. The next screen to appear will be the first screen of the software update. Click
“Next” to continue.
FIGURE 3.
A
B
Page 4 of 10
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 7, 2002
C. Enter the serial number of the battery tester then click “OK.” (Figure 4.)
FIGURE 4.
C
Page 5 of 10
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 7, 2002
D. Connect the Midtronics Battery Tester to TIS as instructed (Figure 5), then click
“Next.”
NOTE:
Connecting the Midtronics Battery Tester to the TIS station will require the use of SST
00002–DMPUC. This is an adapter that allows the TIS RS–232 cable to plug into the
Battery Tester. (Figure 5.)
FIGURE 5.
D
Page 6 of 10
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 7, 2002
E. Follow the instructions to put the Midtronics Battery Tester into the correct mode
(Figure 6), then click “Next.”
FIGURE 6.
E
Page 7 of 10
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 7, 2002
F. Confirm the software version and click “Next.” (Figure 7.)
FIGURE 7.
F
Figures 7–1 and 7–2 are confirmation dialogs that will pop up over the Update
Information window (Figure 7) when:
S The update file is an older revision level than that found in the battery tester
(Figure 7–1) or
S The update file is the same revision level as that found in the tester
(Figure 7–2).
Click the “Yes” button to clear the pop–up dialog and continue with the update.
FIGURE 7–1.
Page 8 of 10
FIGURE 7–2.
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 7, 2002
G. The Midtronics Update Wizard (MUW) will now update the Midtronics Battery
Tester software. (Figure 8.)
NOTE:
Do not interrupt this process (it will take approximately 5 minutes).
FIGURE 8.
Page 9 of 10
MIDTRONICS BATTERY TESTER SOFTWARE UPDATE – SS002-02
Operation
Procedure
(Continued)
June 7, 2002
H. Upon successful completion, the Update Results screen will display “No errors”
and the update is now complete. Click on the “Exit” button. (Figure 9.)
FIGURE 9.
H
Your Midtronics Battery Tester is now updated and ready for use.
NOTE:
BE SURE TO REGULARLY CHECK TIS FOR FUTURE UPDATES:
S The Midtronics Battery Tester OE Stock Number Card will no longer be printed and
shipped. It will be distributed through TIS from now on.
S Latest versions of Tester update software will be available on TIS.
Page 10 of 10
Technical Service
BULLETIN
RIVET NUT TOOL
Models:
All Models
December 11, 1998
Introduction
Affected
Vehicles
Part Number
Information
Toyota Motor Sales is making available a tool suitable for installing Rivet Nuts as required
by some DIO accessories, such as wind deflectors, roof Racks, and running boards. The
tool is available from Owatonna Tool Company, also known as OTC.
S All models requiring Rivet Nuts for the installation of an accessory.
OTC PART NUMBER
PART NAME
NOTE
00002–95161
Rivet Nut Tool
Mandrels for 5, 6 and 8 mm Rivet Nuts included*
* Also includes a molded plastic carrying case, not shown
Ordering
Procedure
Warranty
Information
Rivet Nut Tool may be ordered by calling the OTC Order Desk at 1–800–933–8335. The
introductory price for this tool is $460.00.
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS003–98
Title:
SPECIAL SERVICE
TOOLS
SS95–004
NOVEMBER 10, 1995
ALL MODELS
NEW OIL FILTER WRENCH
Page 1 of 1
Beginning in 1996, Toyota will be standardizing the size of many of its oil filters to the three inch
industry standard. This new filter size is slightly larger than the existing 75mm diameter filter
presently used on many Toyota models. This larger filter will require a three inch oil filter wrench
for easy removal.
Three inch oil filter wrenches are readily available from parts stores and tool dealers, however, for
your convenience, OTC will make this new filter wrench available under P/N 00002–17001. Dealer
cost is $5.75. To order, please call OTC at 1–800–933–8335.
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES U.S.A., INC.
Technical Service
BULLETIN
December 8, 2000
Introduction
Applicable
Diagnostic
Testers
Repair
Procedure
DIAGNOSTIC TESTER COMMUNICATION
ERROR WITH T.I.S.
Models:
All Models
Certain Diagnostic Testers (SST P/N 02002019) may experience a communication
error with the Technical Information System (T.I.S.). To correct this condition, the tester
manufacturer, Vetronix Corporation, will recall and update affected units. The following
explains how to determine which Diagnostic Testers may exhibit this problem and
outlines the procedure to return the tester for repair.
Diagnostic Testers within the serial number range below are known to experience these
communication errors.
STARTING SERIAL NUMBER
ENDING SERIAL NUMBER
31 000000
31 000100
1. Determine the Diagnostic Tester serial
number located on the back of the tester
(see Figure 1).
Figure 1
Back View of Diagnostic Tester
2. If the serial number is within the range
listed above, call Vetronix Toyota
Customer Service at 1-800-321-4889,
ext. 3123, to obtain a pre-paid shipping
package for the Diagnostic Tester.
3. The shipping package will arrive within
2 business days. Secure the tester in
the provided package following the
enclosed shipping instructions.
S/N 31 000100
Diagnostic Testers are guaranteed to be
returned within 3 business days from
receipt at Vetronix (except over
holidays).
NOTE:
This update will be performed free
of charge.
Diagnostic Testers outside of the serial number range above are not affected and do not need
this repair. If a Diagnostic Tester outside this range experiences a similar problem, please call
Dealer Daily Support at 1-877-DL-DAILY or Vetronix Toyota Customer Service at
1-800-321-4889, ext. 3123.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS004-00
Title:
February 16, 2001
Introduction
Models:
All Applicable Models
To make the steering wheel installation procedure similar for all models, the steering
wheel nut tightening torque has been standardized.
Applicable
Vehicles
Warranty
Information
STEERING WHEEL NUT SERVICE
SPECIFICATION
MODEL
MODEL YEARS
TERCEL
EL42, 53
1991 – 1998
ECHO
NCP12
2000
PASEO
EL44, 54
1992 – 1997
COROLLA
AE10#, ZZE110
1993 – 2001
CELICA
AT180, ST18#, AT2#,
ST2#, ZZT23#
1990 – 2000
MR2
SW2#, ZZW30
1991 – 1995; 2000
CAMRY
SXV10, 20, MCV10, 20
1992 – 2000
CAMRY CNG
SXV23
2000 – 2001
CAMRY SOLARA
SXV20, MCV20
1999 – 2000
AVALON
MCX10, 20
1995 – 2000
SUPRA
JZA80
1993 1/2 – 1998
RAV4
SXA1#
1996 – 2000
RAV4 EV
BEA11
1998 – 2000
PREVIA
TRC10, 20
1991 – 1997
SIENNA
MCL10
1998 – 2000
HIGHLANDER
ACU20, 25, MCU20, 25
2001
4RUNNER
RN12#, 13#, VZN12#, 13#,
18#, RZN180, 185
1990 – 2000
LAND CRUISER
FZ80, FZJ80, UZJ100
1991 – 2000
TRUCK
RN8#, 9#, 10#, 110,
VZN85, 9#, 10#, 110
1989 – 1995
TACOMA
RZN140, 150, 161, 171,
19#, VZN150, 160, 170, 195
1995 1/2 – 2000
T100
VCK10, 20
1993 – 1998
TUNDRA
VCK30, 40, UCK30, 40
2000
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
STEERING
Technical Service
BULLETIN
ST001-01
Title:
STEERING WHEEL NUT SERVICE SPECIFICATION – ST001-01
Service
Information
February 16, 2001
Steering Wheel
Installation Nut
35 NSm (360 kgfScm, 26 ftSlbf)
Steering Wheel Pad
50 NSm (510 kgfScm, 37 ftSlbf)
Steering Wheel
Lower
No. 2 Cover
Steering Wheel
Steering Column
Page 2 of 2
Steering Wheel
Lower
No. 3 Cover
Technical Service
BULLETIN
May 22, 1998
Introduction
STEERING GEAR REMOVAL/
REPLACEMENT
Models:
All Models equipped with SRS Airbag
The following information is provided to supplement the Repair Manual procedure for
removing/installing the steering gearbox or rack and pinion on vehicles equipped with a
driver’s side Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Airbag.
CAUTION:
When the intermediate shaft is disconnected and the steering wheel is turned freely,
the SRS spiral cable may be broken. Therefore, as a precaution, make sure to pass
the driver’s seat belt through the steering wheel to prevent it from turning freely, as
shown below.
After working on SRS/Steering components, always check the operation of the SRS
Warning Light. Refer to the appropriate repair manual if any diagnostic trouble codes
are recorded.
Affected
Vehicles
Repair
Procedure
Tercel, Paseo, Corolla, MR2, Celica, Camry, Avalon, Supra, Previa, Sienna, RAV4,
4Runner, Tacoma, T–100 & Land Cruiser equipped with a driver’s side SRS Airbag.
1. Position the front wheels facing
straight ahead.
2. Using the driver’s seat belt, set the
steering wheel so that it does not turn
(see Fig. 1).
Fig. 1
3. Paint match marks on the
intermediate shaft and control valve
shaft (see Fig. 2).
Match Marks
4. Remove the intermediate shaft
retaining bolt and disconnect the
intermediate shaft (see Fig. 2).
Fig.2
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
STEERING
ST002–98
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
STEERING WHEEL NUT
Models:
’94 – ’00 Camry
May 12, 2000
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
The steering wheel installation nut torque specification has been changed. Please update
the repair manuals for the applicable vehicles.
S 1994 – 2000 model year Camry
50 N m (510 kgf cm, 37 ft lbf)
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
STEERING
ST002–00
Title:
STEERING RACK END NOISE
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’97 – ’00 Camry (NAP) & ’99 – ’00 Solara
June 16, 2000
Introduction
Some 1997 – 2000 model year Camry (NAP) and 1999 – 2000 Solara vehicles may
experience a squeaking noise from the front suspension. To improve this condition,
production parts have been changed.
Applicable
Vehicles
S 1997 – 2000 model year Camry (North American Produced)
S 1999 – 2000 model year Solara
Production
Change
Information
Parts
Information
MODEL
STARTING VIN
NAP Camry
4T1BG2*K*YU668756
4T1BG2*K*YU986504
4T1BF2*K*YU104860
4T1BF2*K*YU947590
Solara
2T1C*2*P*YC359722
MODEL
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
Camry
and
Solara
45503–09030
or
45503–39055
or
45503–39135
45503–39135
Steering Rack End
Sub–Assembly
HINT:
A quick reference in differentiating
between the previous and new parts is
that the previous Rack End Shaft is
BLACK and the current part is GRAY.
STEERING
ST004–00
Title:
Previous Part (BLACK SHAFT)
Current Part (GRAY SHAFT)
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
444631
R & R Power Steering Rack End
Sub–Assembly (One Side)
2.2
Other Side
0.5
Combo Code A
OPN
45503–09030
or
45503–39055
45503
39055
or
45503–39135
T1
T2
91 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
STEERING RACK END NOISE
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
’97 – ’00 Camry (NAP) & ’99 – ’00 Solara
December 21, 2001
STEERING
ST008-01
Title:
TSB Update Notice:
The information contained in this TSB updates ST004–00 dated June 16, 2000.
Revised text is red and underlined.
Introduction
Some 1997 – 2000 model year Camry (NAP) and 1999 – 2000 Solara vehicles may
experience a squeaking noise from the front suspension. To improve this condition,
production parts have been changed.
Applicable
Vehicles
S 1997 – 2000 model year Camry (North American Produced) vehicles.
S 1999 – 2000 model year Solara vehicles.
Production
Change
Information
Parts
Information
MODEL
STARTING VIN
NAP Camry
4T1BG2#K#YU668756
4T1BG2#K#YU986504
4T1BF2#K#YU104860
4T1BF2#K#YU947590
Solara
2T1C#2#P#YC359722
MODEL
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
Camry
and
Solara
45503–09030
or
45503–39055
or
45503–39135
45503–39135
Steering Rack End
Sub–Assembly
NOTE:
Current service parts may be GRAY or BLACK in color.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
444631
R & R Power Steering Rack End
Sub–Assembly (One Side)
2.2
Other Side
0.5
Combo Code A
OPN
45503–09030
or
45503–39055
45503
39055
or
45503–39135
T1
T2
91 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
Technical Service
BULLETIN
FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT NOISE
Models:
’97 – ’99 Avalon & ’97 – ’00 Camry
January 21, 2000
TSB Update Notice:
The information contained in this TSB updates SU002–99 dated September 3, 1999.
Revised text is red and underlined.
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Production
Change
Information
Parts
Information
To eliminate a noise occurrence from the front suspension on washboard type road
surfaces, the suspension support has been changed.
S 1997 – 1999 Model Year Avalon and 1997 – 2000 Camry vehicles.
The rubber bushing shape of the
suspension support has been changed.
MODEL
STARTING VIN
Avalon
4T1BF1*B*XU353593
JPP
Camry
JT2BF2*K*Y0237757
JT2BG2*K*Y0386559
NAP
Camry
4T1BF2*K*YU092142
4T1BF2*K*YU934448
4T1BG2*K*YU623567
4T1BG2*K*YU925151
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
Suspension
Support
Coil Spring
Strut
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QUANTITY
48603–33020
48603–33010
Support Sub–Assembly,
Front Suspension RH
1
48609–33120
48609–33110
Support Sub–Assembly,
Front Suspension LH
1
48603–33020
48603–33021
Support Sub–Assembly,
Front Suspension RH
1
48609–33120
48609–33121
Support Sub–Assembly,
Front Suspension LH
1
Avalon
Camry
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
431451
COMBO
DESCRIPTION
A
R & R Suspension Support (RH and LH)
B
Adjust Toe–In
C
Adjust Camber
TIME
OPN
T1
2.1
48603–33020
T2
91 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
SUSPENSION
SU001–00
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 1, 2002
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
REAR BEARING O-RING SERVICE TIP
Models:
’97 – ’01 Camry, ’00 – ’02 Avalon &
’99 – ’02 Solara
When replacing the rear hub bearing assemblies on 1997 – 2001 model year Camry,
2000 – 2002 Avalon and 1999 – 2002 Solara vehicles, replace the O–ring.
S 1997 – 2001 model year Camry vehicles.
S 2000 – 2002 model year Avalon vehicles produced before the VIN shown below.
S 1999 – 2002 model year Solara vehicles produced before the VIN shown below.
Production
Change
Information
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
Repair
Procedure
MODEL
STARTING VIN
Avalon
4T1BF28B#2U223623
Solara
2T1##2#P#2C005335
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
90301–63006
O–Ring
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
REMOVAL
1. Remove Rear Wheel.
Torque: 103 NSm (1,050 kgfScm, 76 ftSlbf)
2. With Disc Brake:
Remove Brake Caliper and Disc.
A. Remove the brake caliper and disc.
Torque: 47 NSm (475 kgfScm, 34 ftSlbf)
B. Support the brake caliper securely.
3. With Drum Brake:
Remove Brake Drum.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
SUSPENSION
SU001-02
Title:
REAR BEARING O–RING SERVICE TIP – SU001-02
March 1, 2002
4. Remove Rear Axle Hub.
A. Remove the 4 bolts and rear
axle hub.
Bolt
Torque: 80 NSm (820 kgfScm, 59 ftSlbf)
B. Remove the O–ring.
Bolt
HINT:
At the time of installation, coat the new
O–ring with MP grease.
Bolt
Bolt
NOTE:
Please ensure that the O–ring is
replaced with a new service part when
installing the bearing assembly.
C. With Drum Brake:
Remove the bolt, and disconnect
the flexible hose from the shock
absorber.
Torque: 29 NSm (300 kgfScm, 22 ftSlbf)
D. Support the backing plate
securely.
5. With ABS:
Remove ABS Speed Sensor.
Torque: 8.0 NSm (82 kgfScm, 71 inSlbf)
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of
removal.
Page 2 of 2
Technical Service
BULLETIN
FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT NOISE
Models:
’97 – ’99 Avalon & Camry
September 3, 1999
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Modification
Information
To eliminate a noise occurrence from the front suspension on washboard type road
surfaces, the suspension support has been changed.
S 1997 – 1999 Model Year Avalon and Camry vehicles
The rubber bushing shape of the
suspension support has been changed.
Suspension Support
Coil spring
Strut
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
PREVIOUS PART
NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QUANTITY
48603–33020
48603–33010
Support Sub–Assembly,
Front Suspension RH
1
48609–33120
48609–33110
Support Sub–Assembly,
Front Suspension LH
1
OP CODE
431451
GROUP
DESCRIPTION
A
R & R Suspension Support
(RH and LH)
B
Adjust Toe–In
C
Adjust Camber
TIME
2.1
OPN
T1
T2
48603–33020 91 99
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for
36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s in–service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
SUSPENSION
SU002–99
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REAR ABS SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
Models:
’97 – ’00 Camry & Avalon, ’99 – ’00 Solara
May 5, 2000
Introduction
This bulletin provides service information regarding the removal of the ABS speed sensor
prior to removal of the rear axle and rear suspension.
REMINDER:
Failure to remove the ABS speed sensor prior to removal of the rear axle or
suspension may cause the ABS warning light to illuminate or damage the ABS speed
sensor wire harness.
Applicable
Vehicles
S 1997 – 2000 model year Camry and Avalon
S 1999 – 2000 model year Solara
Repair
Procedure
POTENTIAL AREA FOR DAMAGE
5.4 NSm (55 kgfScm, 48 inSlbf)
REAR ABS SPEED SENSOR
7.8 NSm (80 kfgScm, 69 inSlbf)
NOTE:
Prior to removal/replacement of the rear axle, rear coil spring and rear shock absorber,
be sure to remove the rear ABS speed sensor from the rear axle by removing the 3
bolts shown above. Check the speed sensor signal after installation.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
SUSPENSION
SU002–00
Title:
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
REQUIREMENTS
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
All ’00 – ’02 Models & ’03 Corolla & Matrix
May 24, 2002
Introduction
Please refer to the following table for correct application of DexronR III (DexronR II) and
Toyota Type T–IV Automatic Transmission Fluids or equivalent.
MODEL
2000
2001
2002
2003
Avalon
A541E
A541E
A541E
N/A
Camry
A140E, A541E
A140E, A541E
U140E, U241E
N/A
Celica
U240E, U341E
U240E, U341E
U240E, U341E
N/A
Corolla
A131L, A245E
A131L, A245E
A131L, A245E
A245E
ECHO
U340E
U340E
U340E
N/A
Highlander
N/A
U140E, U140F,
U241E
U140E, U140F,
U241E
N/A
Land Cruiser
A343F
A343F
A343F
N/A
U140F, U241E
U140F, U241E
N/A
RAV4
A247E
A540H
Sequoia
N/A
A340E, A340F
A340E, A340F
N/A
Sienna
A540E
A541E
A541E
N/A
Solara
A140E, A541E
A140E, A541E
Tacoma
A340E, A340F, A43D
A340E, A340F, A44D
A340E, A340F, A44D
N/A
Tundra
A340E, A340F
A340E, A340F
A340E, A340F
N/A
4Runner
A340E, A340F
A340E, A340F
A340E, A340F
N/A
Matrix
N/A
N/A
N/A
A246E
Matrix
N/A
N/A
N/A
U240E
Matrix
N/A
N/A
N/A
U341F
Prius
N/A
P111
P111
N/A
A140E
U241E
N/A
LEGEND
Type T–IV Fluid
DexronR III (DexronR II)
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
08886–81015
ATF Type T–IV
00718–ATF00
DexronR III (DexronR II)
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC001-02
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
REVISED DRIVE SHAFT GREASE
Models:
RAV4, Tercel, Corolla, Celica, Camry & Supra
April 9, 1999
Introduction
The greases supplied in replacement Inboard and Outboard Drive Shaft Boot Kits for the
following models has been revised.
With this revision, the grease compositions have been changed and are now both the
same color. To correctly lubricate each joint, consult the Service Repair Manual as to
which size packet of grease is designated for each Drive Shaft Joint Assembly.
NOTE:
Although Inboard and Outboard greases are now the same color, their compositions
are different.
Affected
Vehicles
S All RAV4, Tercel, Corolla, Celica, Camry and Supra Models.
Required
Tools and
Material
As outlined in the Service Repair Manual.
Repair
Procedure
Refer to the appropriate Repair Manual for installation and lubrication information for
Drive Shaft Joint Assemblies.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC002–99
Title:
TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER INSTALLATION
Models:
’97 CAMRY WITH A541E ATM
October 17, 1997
Introduction
Towing
Capacity
To prevent overheating of the transmission when towing a weight of more than 1,000
pounds, a transmission oil cooler should be installed. The transmission oil cooler and
required hardware for installation are available through normal parts supply.
D Up to 2,000 pounds (with transmission cooler installed).
Oil Cooler Tube No. 2
Oil Cooler Tube No. 1
Side Member
Clip
Front Suspension Member
Hose
Clamp
Oil Cooler Assembly
Fig. 1
Affected
Vehicles
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
D 1997 Camrys with A541E Automatic Transmissions.
PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QTY
32910–33040
Oil Cooler Assembly
1
32907–33050
Oil Cooler Tube No. 2
1
32907–33090
Oil Cooler Tube No. 1
1
90445–17101
180 mm (7.09”) Oil Cooler Hose
1
90445–17069
190 mm (7.48”) Oil Cooler Hose
1
90445–17139
130 mm (5.12”) Oil Cooler Hose
3
90445–17151
140 mm (5.51”) Oil Cooler Hose
1
90119–06518
Bolt
3
91611–60816
Bolt
2
90467–16013
Hose Clamp with installation clip
12
90179–06058
Nut
1
OPCODE
N/A
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
DESCRIPTION
Not applicable to warranty
TIME
–
OPN
–
T1
T2
–
–
Page 1 of 6
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TSB
TC003–97
Title:
TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER INSTALLATION – TC003–97
Procedure
October 17, 1997
1. Parts removal in preparation for cooler
installation:
A. Remove the 9 bolts, 2 screws and
the center engine under cover.
Fig. 2
Center Engine Under Cover
B. Remove the engine coolant
temperature switch connector and
the wire clamp.
Fig. 3
C. Remove battery and tray.
D. Disconnect the cooling fan
connector.
E. Disconnect the No.1 engine coolant
temperature switch wire connector.
F. Remove the 2 bolts and then the
cooling fan.
Fig. 4
Page 2 of 6
Clamp
Switch
TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER INSTALLATION – TC003–97
October 17, 1997
Oil Cooler Tube No. 1
Procedure
(Continued)
2. Cooler Installation:
A. Install the 140 mm (5.51”) hose to
the oil cooler tube No. 1 as shown.
NOTE:
Install the hose clamp with the hose
clamp clip at the position shown, and
use pliers to pull off the clip in the
direction indicated by the arrow.
140 mm Hose
5 mm (0.20”)
Fig. 5
B. Install the tube bracket onto the left
side of the front suspension
member with the 2 bolts as shown.
Torque: 62 in–lbf
(7 N–m / 71 kgf–cm)
Fig. 6
C. Install the 130 mm (5.12”) hoses
and the 180 mm (7.09”) hose to the
oil cooler tube No. 2 as shown.
Oil Cooler Tube No. 2
NOTE:
Install the hose clamps with the hose
clamp clips at the positions shown,
and use pliers to pull off the clips in
the direction indicated by the arrows.
180 mm Hose
130 mm Hose
5 mm (0.20”)
Fig. 7
Page 3 of 6
TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER INSTALLATION – TC003–97
Procedure
(Continued)
October 17, 1997
D. Remove the lower side clip of the
radiator side LH deflector.
E. Install the tube bracket with the bolt
on the side member.
Torque: 62 in–lbf
(7 N–m / 71 kgf–cm)
F. Reinstall the lower side clip
of the radiator LH deflector.
Fig. 8
G. Connect the hoses from the oil
cooler tube No. 2 to the oil cooler
tube No.1.
Oil Cooler Tube No. 1
NOTE:
Install the hose clamps with the hose
clamp clips at the positions shown, and
use pliers to pull off the clips in the
direction indicated by the arrows.
Front Suspension Member
5 mm (0.20”)
Fig. 9
H. Disconnect the hose from the oil
cooler pipe of the radiator LH side.
NOTE:
Place a container below vehicle to catch
any leaking ATF. Remove the other end
of this hose from transaxle and discard.
I. Connect the hose from oil cooler
tube No.1 to the oil cooler pipe of
the radiator LH side.
NOTE:
Install the hose clamps with the hose
clamp clips at the positions shown, and
use pliers to pull off the clips in the
direction indicated by the arrows.
Page 4 of 6
5 mm (0.20”)
Fig. 10
TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER INSTALLATION – TC003–97
Procedure
(Continued)
October 17, 1997
J. Install the 190 mm (7.48”) hose
between the oil cooler tube No.1
and transaxle oil cooler tube.
NOTE:
Install the hose clamps with the hose
clamp clips at the positions shown, and
use pliers to pull off the clips in the
direction indicated by the arrows.
190 mm Hose
Oil Cooler Tube No. 1
5 mm (0.20”)
Fig. 11
K. Install the oil cooler onto the center
brace and front cross member
using the two bolts and nut as
illustrated in figure 12.
Torque: 65.5 in–lbf
(7.4 N–m/75.5 kgf–cm)
L. Connect the hoses to the pipes.
NOTE:
Install the hose clamps with the hose
clamp clips at the positions shown, and
use pliers to pull off the clips in the
direction indicated by the arrows.
5 mm (0.20”)
Fig. 13
Page 5 of 6
TRANSMISSION OIL COOLER INSTALLATION – TC003–97
Procedure
(Continued)
October 17, 1997
3. Final Assembly:
A. Reconnect the coolant temperature
switch connector and wire clamp as
illustrated in figure 14.
B. Install the cooling fan with 2 bolts.
C. Reconnect the cooling fan
connector and the No.1 engine
temperature switch wire connector
as shown in figure 15.
D. Reinstall battery and tray.
E. Start the engine.
Fig. 15
F. With the engine at idle and the
brake pedal depressed, shift the
selector into all positions from “P” to
“L”, and return it to the “P” position.
G. Check for leaks from the hose joints.
H. Add new fluid type ATF D·II or
DEXRON·III (DEXRON·II).
Fig. 16
NOTE:
Additional capacity with cooler will be
0.38 US quarts (0.36 liters).
I. Shift the selector into all positions
from “P” to “L”, and return to “P”.
J. Check fluid level with engine idling
at normal operating temperature of
158 to 176F (70 to 80C) and add
more fluid if required.
Fig. 17
CAUTION:
Do not overfill.
K. Shut off the engine and reinstall the
center engine under cover with 9
bolts and 2 screws as shown in
figure 18.
Fig. 18
Page 6 of 6
Technical Service
BULLETIN
June 19, 1998
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
TYPE T-IV
Models:
All Models
The introduction of Automatic Transmission Fluid type T–IV makes type T–II obsolete.
Use type T–IV for all applications that specify ATF type T–II.
S All vehicles with Automatic Transmissions specified to use ATF Types T–II or T–IV.
TYPE OF ATF
SPECIFIED ATF
Dextron®–III
TYPE T
TYPE T–II
TYPE T–IV
Dextron®–II or III
OK
X
X
X
TYPE T
X
OK
X
X
TYPE T–II
X
X
OK
OK
TYPE T–IV
X
X
X
OK
X = NOT USABLE
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
SIZE
NEW PART NUMBER
PART NAME
4 Liter
08886–01705
ATF type T–IV
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC003–98
Title:
Technical Service
BULLETIN
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUIDS
Models:
All Models
May 21, 1999
REVISION NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates TC003–98 dated June 19, 1998.
Introduction
Automatic Transmission Fluid Type T–IV now replaces Type T–II fluid. Use Type T–IV for
all applications that specify ATF Type T–II.
Please refer to the following table for the interchangeability between each ATF.
Affected
Vehicles
S All vehicles produced after 1993 with Automatic Transmissions specified to use
ATF Type T, T–II and T–IV.
TYPE OF ATF
SPECIFIED ATF
DEXTRON II OR III
TYPE T
TYPE T–II
TYPE T–IV
DEXTRON II OR III
OK
X
X
X
TYPE T
X
OK
X
OK
TYPE T–II
X
X
OK
OK
TYPE T–IV
X
X
X
OK
X = NOT USABLE
NOTICE:
With the exception of mixing ATF Type T with Type T–IV fluids, different types of fluids
must not be mixed.
Parts
Information
Warranty
Information
SIZE
NEW PART NUMBER
PART NAME
4 Liter
08886–01705
ATF Type T–IV
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OPN
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 1
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH
TC003–99
Title:
TRANSMISSION &
CLUTCH
TC004-96
DECEMBER 20, 1996
ALL MODELS
Title: AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBERS
Page 1 of 3
Use the following tables to locate and read the original automatic transmission serial number.
TRANSMISSION
MODEL
A4#D#
A34##
TRANSMISSION
LOCATION
SERIAL NUMBER
96 A E 00001
5-Digit Serial No.
*Model Code
Manufacturing Month:
A thru M (“I” not used)
Last 2 Digits of
Manufacturing Year:
1996
A131L
(AW Product)
96 A Y 00001
5-Digit Serial No.
*Model Code
Manufacturing Month:
A thru M (“I” not used)
Last 2 Digits of
Manufacturing Year:
1996
A24##
96 A ZT 00001
5-Digit Serial No.
*Model Code
Manufacturing Month:
A thru M (“I” not used)
Last 2 Digits of
Manufacturing Year:
1996
*See Model Code chart on Page 3.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBERS
TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
LOCATION
MODEL
Page 2 of 3
SERIAL NUMBER
6 A 00001
50001
5-Digit Serial No.
Manufacturing Month:
A thru M (“I” not used)
Last Digit of
Manufacturing Year:
1996
A140#
A130L
6 01 00001
5-Digit Serial No.
Manufacturing Month:
Last 2 Digits of
Manufacturing Year:
1996
A131L
(TMC Product)
A132#
F A 50001
5-Digit Serial No.
Manufacturing Month:
A thru M (“I” not used)
*Manufacturing Year:
‘93-C, ‘94-D, ‘95-E
A54#E
A540H
D 01 00001
5-Digit Serial No.
Manufacturing Month:
Manufacturing Year:
A541E:
‘93-A, ‘94-B, ‘95-C
A540E, A540H:
‘90-A, ‘91-B, ‘92-C
A44##
*
NOTE:
6 A 00001
5-Digit Serial No.
Manufacturing Month:
A thru M (“I” not used)
Last Digit of
Manufacturing Year:
1996
Exception: 1991 – K, 1992 (January–March) – M, 1992 (April–December) – B
Remanufactured transmissions also have an additional serial number.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION SERIAL NUMBERS
Page 3 of 3
MODEL CODE CHART:
CODE
MODEL
A
A40
N
A45DF, A44D, A45D
w/o Lock-up
B
A40D, A40DF
P
A44DL, A45DF, A45DL
w/Lock-up
C
A42D
Q
A44DE, A45DF, A45DE
ECT, w/Lock-up
D
A41
R
A340E, A340F
w/lock-up
E
A343F
S
A340H
w/Lock-up
F
A43D
T
A340E
w/o Lock-up
H
A43DL
U
A341H
K
A42DL
Y
A131, A131L
Z
A240L, A241L, A242L,
A243L, A2444L, A240E,
A241E, A242E, A244E,
A244F, A241H
ZT
A245E, A246E
L
A43DE, A46DE, A46DF
M
A42DE
CODE
MODEL
TOYOTA
SERVICE BULLETIN
VOLUME
10
TRANSMISSION &
REFERENCE CLUTCH
NUMBER
DATE
008 (REVISED)
03–22–02
MODELAE,
ST, SV, VV
(A131L) BR12E or BR18E
(A140E) BG, EG, CG, FG, DG
(A540e) ZF, GF19C
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
Page 1 of 2
A/TM NUMBER AND LOCATION INFORMATION
The purpose of this Service Bulletin is to provide information regarding the location of the A/TM
numbers.
NOTE:
The transmission numbers must be included on the AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION CORE
INFORMATION/CREDIT REQUEST FORM when using the automatic transmission reman.
program.
TECHNICAL ASSURANCE DEPARTMENT
TC008–89
Page 2 of 2
A/TM NUMBER AND LOCATION INFORMATION (CONT’D)
TECHNICAL ASSURANCE DEPARTMENT
TC008–89
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05)
Technical Service
BULLETIN
December 17, 2003
Introduction
All ’96 – ’03, ’04 Corolla, ECHO, Matrix, Sienna
& Scion xA & xB
This Service Bulletin contains Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor threshold values for all
models from 1996 to 2003 and some 2004 models. Starting in 2004, the O2S Monitor
threshold values can be found in the repair manual. These values are used when
analyzing the O2S test results to determine the O2S condition.
S All 1996 – 2003 model year Toyota vehicles.
S 2004 model year Corolla, ECHO, Matrix and Sienna vehicles.
S 2004 model year Scion xA and xB vehicles.
Applicable
Vehicles
Function
Description
Models:
Checking O2S Test Results
To view O2S test results, the O2S Monitor must be completed and the test results must
be checked within the same key cycle. If the ignition key is cycled OFF, the O2S test
results will be set to the minimum or maximum limits, and all test results will be erased.
The O2S test results are stored in the ECU (SAE term: Powertrain Control Module/PCM)
when the monitor is completed. The test results are static and will not change once the
monitor is complete.
The process for checking O2S test results is described in the following three basic steps:
1. Completing the O2S Readiness Monitor (page 2).
2. Accessing O2S Test Results (page 3).
3. Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds (page 4).
Required
SSTs
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit*
(or any OBDII Scantool)
12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
with version 10.1a Software (or later)*
*
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
01001271
1
01002593-005
1
Essential SSTs.
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, Program Cards or other SSTs may be ordered by
calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 43
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS
SS002-03
Title:
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
Completing
O2S
Readiness
Monitor
December 17, 2003
1. Clear any stored Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) using the Toyota
Diagnostic Tester.
2. Start the engine.
3. Perform the drive pattern below to run and complete the Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor.
O2S Monitor Drive Pattern
ECT: 167F (75C) or more
Accelerator Pedal
Depressing
At Least Twice
At Least 8 Times
Vehicle Speed
Accelerator Pedal
Releasing (Fuel–Cut)
48 km/h (30 mph)
6 mph
(10 km/h)
Idling
Time
2 min.
or more
40 sec
or more
20 sec
or more
10 sec
or more
10 sec
or more
HINT:
The O2S Monitor is completed when the following conditions are met:
S Two (2) minutes or more passed after the engine start.
S The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 167F (75C) or more.
S Cumulative running time at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more exceeds 6 minutes.
S Vehicle is in closed loop.
S The fuel–cut is operated for 8 seconds or more (for Rear O2S Monitor).
A. Allow the engine to idle for two minutes.
B. Warm up the engine until the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) reaches 167F
(75C).
C. Drive the vehicle over 30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 40 seconds.
D. Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for more than 20 seconds.
E. Repeat steps C and D at least 8 times in one driving cycle.
(Do not cycle the ignition key.)
In addition, perform the following steps for the Rear O2S Readiness Monitor:
A. Select second gear.
B. Allow the vehicle to run at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more.
C. Keep the accelerator pedal “off–idle” for more than 10 seconds.
D. Immediately after step C, release the accelerator pedal for at least 10 seconds
without depressing the brake pedal (to execute the fuel–cut).
E. Decelerate the vehicle until the vehicle speed reaches less than 6 mph (10 km/h).
F. Repeat steps B – E at least twice in one driving cycle.
Page 2 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
Accessing
O2S Test
Results
1. On the Diagnostic Tester* screen,
select the following menus:
S DIAGNOSTICS
S CARB OBD II
S O2S TEST RESULTS
A list of the available oxygen sensors
will be displayed.
December 17, 2003
O2S TEST RESULT Screen
01 BANK 1 – SENSOR 1
01 BANK 1 – SENSOR 2
01 BANK 2 – SENSOR 1
01 BANK 2 – SENSOR 2
2. Select the desired oxygen sensor and
press Enter.
NOTE:
The monitor result of the A/F sensor will
not be displayed. If you select
“Bank 1–Sensor 1” or Bank 2–Sensor 1”
for a vehicle equipped with an A/F
sensor, the Diagnostic Tester will
display “No parameter to display.”
3. Compare the test results with the
values listed in the Failure
Threshold Chart.
TEST DATA Screen
LOW SW V S S S S 0.400 V
HIGH SW V S S S S 0.550 V
MIN O2S V S S S S
0.100 V
MAX O2S V S S S S 0.900 V
TIME $81 S S S S S
*
17
Although this procedure references the Toyota
Diagnostic Tester, the O2S test results can be
checked using a generic OBDII scantool.
Refer to your OBDII scantool operator’s manual
for specific procedures.
Page 3 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
Comparing
O2S Test
Results to
Failure
Thresholds
December 17, 2003
1. Determine the correct O2S Failure Threshold Chart for your vehicle by looking in the
“O2S Application Table,” pages 5 – 9 in this bulletin.
2. Select appropriate year, model, and engine for specified O2S Failure
Threshold Chart.
3. Compare O2S test results with the specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart. It may be
necessary to convert O2S test results to a specific measurement unit using the
conversion factor that is supplied in the specified table. See example below:
Example:
Example
A. The Diagnostic Tester displays
“17” as a value of the “Time $81”
(see illustration).
B. Find the Conversion Factor value
of “Time $81” in the O2S Failure
Threshold chart below.
0.3906 is specified for Time $81
in this chart.
C. Multiply “17” in step “A” by 0.3906
(Conversion Factor) in step “B.”
17 x 0.3906 = 6.6 %
D. If the answer is within the
Standard Value of TEST LIMIT,
the “Time $81” can be confirmed
to be normal.
LOW SW V S S S S
HIGH SW V S S S S
MIN O2S V S S S S
MAX O2S V S S S S
Time $81
Time $84
Time $85
0.400 V
0.550 V
0.035 V
0.835 V
17
84
79
NOTE:
S “LOW SW V” indicates the O2S
voltage when the O2S status changes
from rich to lean.
S “HIGH SW V” indicates the O2S
voltage when the O2S status changes
from lean to rich.
S If the O2S voltage is lower than
“LOW SW V,” the O2S status is lean.
S If the O2S voltage is higher than
“HIGH SW V,” the O2S status is rich.
Example of O2S Failure Threshold Chart:
TEST ID
Time
$81
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05V
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
Multiply 0.3906
%
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Within 60%
NOTE:
Before the O2S Monitor completes or after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the
Diagnostic Tester displays the viewable upper limit or a lower limit of the test value
(example: 0 V, 1.275 V, 0 s [seconds], 10.2 s, 0 and 255).
Page 4 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Application
Table
MODEL YEAR
MODEL
ENGINE
DRIVE TRAIN
CERTIFICATION
SEE CHART NO.
(TSB PAGE)
Avalon
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
All
California
2 (p. 11)
All
Federal
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
7A–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
All
California
2 (p. 11)
All
Federal
1 (p. 10)
Camry
y
Celica
1996
5S FE
5S–FE
5S FE
5S–FE
1 (p
(p. 10)
Corolla
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Land Cruiser
1FZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Paseo
5E–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Previa
2TZ–FZE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
RAV4
3S–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Supra
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Tacoma
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Tercel
5E–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
T100
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
4Runner
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Avalon
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
All
California
3 (p. 12)
All
Federal
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
7A–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
All
California
2 (p. 11)
All
Federal
1 (p. 10)
Camry
y
Celica
1997
December 17, 2003
5S FE
5S–FE
5S FE
5S–FE
1 (p
(p. 10)
Corolla
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Land Cruiser
1FZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Paseo
5E–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Previa
2TZ–FZE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
RAV4
3S–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Supra
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
2RZ–FE
All
50–State
A/T
50–State
M/T, 2WD
50–State
M/T, 4WD
50–State
5VZ–FE
All
50–State
5E–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
3RZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
5VZ–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
3RZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
5VZ–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Tacoma
Tercel
T100
4Runner
3RZ–FE
1 ((p. 10))
2 (p
(p. 11)
Page 5 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Application
Table
(Continued)
MODEL YEAR
December 17, 2003
MODEL
ENGINE
Avalon
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
5S FE
5S–FE
Camry
y
1MZ–FE
1998
SEE CHART NO.
(TSB PAGE)
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
1 (p. 10)
All
California
3 (p. 12)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
California
4 (p. 12)
A/T
Federal
1 (p.
(p 10)
M/T
50–State
All
California
2 (p. 11)
All
Federal
1 (p. 10)
5S FE
5S–FE
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Land Cruiser
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Paseo
5E–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
All
California
3 (p. 12)
RAV4
3S FE
3S–FE
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
Sienna
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
2JZ–GE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
2JZ–GTE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Tacoma
ALL
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Tercel
5E–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
T100
ALL
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
4Runner
ALL
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
5 (p. 13)
Avalon
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
Camry CNG
5S–FNE
All
50–State
6 (p. 13)
Celica
5S–FE
All
50–State
5 (p. 13)
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Land Cruiser
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Paseo
5E–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
All
California
3 (p. 12)
RAV4
3S FE
3S–FE
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
All
California
4 (p. 12)
Sienna
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
All
Federal
5 (p. 13)
All
California
3 (p. 12)
All
Federal
5 (p. 13)
California
4 (p. 12)
5S FE
5S–FE
Solara
1MZ–FE
A/T
Federal
M/T
50–State
5 (p.
(p 13)
Tacoma
ALL
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
Tercel
5E–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
3RZ–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
4Runner
Page 6 of 43
CERTIFICATION
Celica
Supra
1999
DRIVE TRAIN
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Application
Table
(Continued)
MODEL YEAR
December 17, 2003
MODEL
ENGINE
DRIVE TRAIN
CERTIFICATION
SEE CHART NO.
(TSB PAGE)
Avalon
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
Camry CNG
5S–FNE
All
50–State
6 (p. 13)
Celica
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
7 (p. 14)
ECHO
1NZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Land Cruiser
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
MR2
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
RAV4
3S FE
3S–FE
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
5 (p. 13)
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
5 (p. 13)
California
4 (p. 12)
Sienna
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
5S FE
5S–FE
Solara
1MZ–FE
2000
2RZ FE
2RZ–FE
Tacoma
3RZ FE
3RZ–FE
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
2UZ–FE
Tundra
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
3RZ FE
3RZ–FE
4Runner
5VZ FE
5VZ–FE
A/T
Federal
5 (p
(p. 13)
M/T
50–State
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
All
California
8 (p. 15)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
All
50–State
2 (p. 11)
All
California
8 (p. 15)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
All
California
4 (p. 12)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
All
California
8 (p. 15)
All
Federal
2 (p. 11)
Page 7 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Application
Table
(Continued)
MODEL YEAR
MODEL
ENGINE
DRIVE TRAIN
CERTIFICATION
SEE CHART NO.
(TSB PAGE)
Avalon
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
Camry CNG
5S–FNE
All
50–State
6 (p. 13)
Celica
ALL
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
7 (p. 14)
ECHO
1NZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
9 (p. 15)
2AZ–FE
All
50–State
3 (p. 12)
Land Cruiser
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
MR2
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Prius
1NZ–FXE
All
50–State
11 (p. 17)
RAV4
1AZ–FE
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
Sequoia
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Sienna
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
5S–FE
All
50–State
3 (p. 12)
Highlander
2001
A/T
50–State
9 (p. 15)
M/T
50–State
10 (p. 16)
ALL
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
5VZ–FE
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
4Runner
ALL
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
Avalon
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
2ZZ–GE
All
50–State
13 (p. 19)
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
7 (p. 14)
ECHO
1NZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
Solara
Tacoma
Tundra
Celica
Highlander
2002
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
2AZ–FE
All
50–State
3 (p. 12)
Land Cruiser
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
14 (p. 20)
MR2
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
1 (p. 10)
Prius
1NZ–FXE
All
50–State
15 (p. 21)
RAV4
1AZ–FE
All
50–State
3 (p. 12)
Sequoia
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
14 (p. 20)
Sienna
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
4 (p. 12)
2AZ–FE
All
50–State
12 (p. 18)
A/T
50–State
9 (p. 15)
M/T
50–State
5 (p. 13)
ALL
All
50–State
12 (p. 18)
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
14 (p. 20)
5VZ–FE
All
50–State
12 (p. 18)
ALL
All
50–State
12 (p. 18)
Solara
Tacoma
Tundra
4Runner
Page 8 of 43
December 17, 2003
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Application
Table
(Continued)
MODEL YEAR
December 17, 2003
MODEL
ENGINE
DRIVE TRAIN
CERTIFICATION
SEE CHART NO.
(TSB PAGE)
Avalon
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
16 (p. 22)
All
Federal
2AZ–FE
M/T
California
A/T
California
18 (p. 24)
All
With VVT
19 (p. 25)
All
Without VVT
20 (p. 26)
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
13 (p. 19)
Camry
y
1MZ FE
1MZ–FE
Celica
2ZZ–GE
All
50–State
21 (p. 27–28)
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
22 (p. 29)
ECHO
1NZ–FE
All
50–State
23 (p. 30–31)
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
16 (p. 22)
2AZ–FE
All
50–State
12 (p. 18)
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
24 (p. 32–33)
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
22 (p. 29)
Highlander
Land Cruiser
2003
Matrix
2ZZ–GE
All
50–State
21 (p. 27–28)
MR2
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
13 (p. 19)
Prius
1NZ–FXE
All
50–State
15 (p. 21)
RAV4
1AZ–FE
All
50–State
25 (p. 34)
Sequoia
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
24 (p. 32–33)
Sienna
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
16 (p. 22)
Solara
Tacoma
Tundra
4Runner
2004
17 (p.
(p 23)
2AZ–FE
All
50–State
17 (p. 23)
1MZ–FE
All
50–State
20 (p. 26)
ALL
All
50–State
16 (p. 22)
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
24 (p. 32–33)
5VZ–FE
All
50–State
16 (p. 22)
1GR–FE
All
50–State
12 (p. 18)
2UZ–FE
All
50–State
26 (p. 35–36)
Corolla
1ZZ–FE
All
50–State
27 (p. 37–38)
ECHO
1NZ–FE
All
50–State
23 (p. 30–31)
2WD
50–State
27 (p. 37–38)
4WD
50–State
28 (p. 39–40)
2ZZ–GE
All
50–State
29 (41–42)
Matrix
1ZZ FE
1ZZ–FE
Sienna
3MZ–FE
All
50–State
30 (p. 43)
Scion xA
1NZ–FE
All
50–State
23 (p. 30–31)
Scion xB
1NZ–FE
All
50–State
23 (p. 30–31)
Page 9 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
December 17, 2003
CHART 1:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during O2S
monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1 second
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≥0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1 second
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during O2S
monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 10 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 2:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.35 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.35 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1.1 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≥0.35 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1.1 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 11 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 3:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.45 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
CHART 4:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 12 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 5:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1.1 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1.1 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
CHART 6:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.55 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 1 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 13 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 7:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 14 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 8:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.35 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.35 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1 second
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.35 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1 second
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
CHART 9:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.5 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 15 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 10:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1.1 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1.1 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.5 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 16 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 11:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.42 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.48 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.42 V) to Rich (≥0.48 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.4 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.48 V) to Lean (≤0.42 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.4 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.45 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 17 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 12:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.45 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≤0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 18 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 13:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
1 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.5 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 19 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 14:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.5 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 90%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 20 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 15:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.42 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.48 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.42 V) to Rich (≥0.48 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.4 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.48 V) to Lean (≤0.42 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.4 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.45 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.5 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 80%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 10 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 21 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 16:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.5 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 22 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 17:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.45 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 55%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 23 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 18:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.2 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 3) Deterioration Monitor
Related DTCs: P0142
TEST ID
Time
$86
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Average of the second
impedance ratio between high–
frequency and low–frequency
CONVERSION
FACTOR
Multiply 0.0312
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
%
Between 0.7 and 1.35
If the average of the sensor impedance ratio is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this
as a malfunction.
Page 24 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 19:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.5 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 95%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 25 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 20:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.5 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 80%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 26 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 21:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.8 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.8 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Engine Idling
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$33
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
3.05 seconds
Time
$34
Average Rich (≥0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
3.05 seconds
If the sum of Time $33 and Time $34 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Page 27 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 21 (Continued):
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Vehicle Running
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
Time
$35
Time
$36
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
Average Rich (≤0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
CONVERSION
FACTOR
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
UNIT
N/A
Between 0 and
0.95 seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
N/A
Between 0 and 0.95
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
If the sum of Time $35 and Time $36 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 28 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 22:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.5 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 29 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 23:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Engine Idling
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$33
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
4.5 seconds
Time
$34
Average Rich (≤0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
4.5 seconds
If the sum of Time $33 and Time $34 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Page 30 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 23 (Continued):
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Vehicle Running
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
Time
$35
Time
$36
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
Average Rich (≤0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
CONVERSION
FACTOR
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
UNIT
N/A
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
N/A
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
If the sum of Time $35 and Time $36 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 31 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 24:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Engine Idling
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$33
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
2.8 seconds
Time
$34
Average Rich (≥0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
2.8 seconds
If the sum of Time $33 and Time $34 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Page 32 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 24 (Continued):
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Vehicle Running
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
Time
$35
Time
$36
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
Average Rich (≤0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
CONVERSION
FACTOR
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
UNIT
N/A
Between 0 and 0.75
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
N/A
Between 0 and 0.75
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
If the sum of Time $35 and Time $36 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 90%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 33 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 25:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.45 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.6 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 80%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 34 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 26:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.55 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.4 V) to Rich (≥0.55 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.55 V) to Lean (≤0.4 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.9 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Engine Idling
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$33
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
2.8 seconds
Time
$34
Average Rich (≥0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
2.8 seconds
If the sum of Time $33 and Time $34 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Page 35 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 26 (Continued):
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Vehicle Running
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
Time
$35
Time
$36
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
Average Rich (≤0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
CONVERSION
FACTOR
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
UNIT
N/A
Between 0 and
0.75 seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
N/A
Between 0 and
0.75 seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
If the sum of Time $35 and Time $36 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 36 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 27:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.35 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.45 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.35 V) to Rich (≥0.45 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.6 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.45 V) to Lean (≤0.35 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.6 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Engine Idling
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$33
Average Lean (≤0.35 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
3 seconds
Time
$34
Average Rich (≥0.45 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
3 seconds
If the sum of Time $33 and Time $34 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Page 37 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 27 (Continued):
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Vehicle Running
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
Time
$35
Time
$36
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Average Lean (≤0.35 V) time of
one waveform cycle
Average Rich (≤0.45 V) time of
one waveform cycle
CONVERSION
FACTOR
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
UNIT
N/A
Between 0 and 0.55
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
N/A
Between 0 and 0.55
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
If the sum of Time $35 and Time $36 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 38 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 28:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0130, P0150, P2195, P2196, P2197 and P2198
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.35 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.45 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Response Monitor
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$31
Time to change from Lean
(≤0.35 V) to Rich (≥0.45 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.6 seconds
Time
$32
Time to change from Rich
(≥0.45 V) to Lean (≤0.35 V)
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
0.6 seconds
If the time required to change is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Engine Idling
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$33
Average Lean (≤0.35 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
2 seconds
Time
$34
Average Rich (≥0.45 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
2 seconds
If the sum of Time $33 and Time $34 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Page 39 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 28 (Continued):
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Vehicle Running
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
Time
$35
Time
$36
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Average Lean (≤0.35 V) time of
one waveform cycle
Average Rich (≤0.45 V) time of
one waveform cycle
CONVERSION
FACTOR
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
UNIT
N/A
Between 0 and 0.5
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
N/A
Between 0 and 0.5
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
If the sum of Time $35 and Time $36 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 40 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 29:
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Engine Idling
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$33
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
4 seconds
Time
$34
Average Rich (≥0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
N/A
Second
Between 0 and
4 seconds
If the sum of Time $33 and Time $34 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Front O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 1 and Bank 2 Sensor 1) Frequency Monitor During
Vehicle Running
Related DTCs: P0133 and P0153
TEST ID
Time
$35
Time
$36
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
Average Lean (≤0.4 V) time of
one waveform cycle
Average Rich (≥0.55 V) time of
one waveform cycle
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
N/A
Between 0 and 1.08
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
N/A
Between 0 and 1.08
seconds
Second (varies depending
on feedback
compensation factor)
If the sum of Time $35 and Time $36 is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a
malfunction.
Page 41 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 29 (Continued):
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and 0.4 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 60%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 42 of 43
O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05) – SS002-03
O2S
Failure
Threshold
Charts
(Continued)
December 17, 2003
CHART 30:
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Voltage Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$07
The minimum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0 and
0.45 V
Time
$08
The maximum voltage during
O2S monitoring
N/A
V
Between 0.5 and
1.275 V
If the sensor voltage is out of the standard value, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction.
Rear O2S (Bank 1 Sensor 2 and Bank 2 Sensor 2) Element Monitor
Related DTCs: P0136 and P0156
TEST ID
DESCRIPTION OF TEST DATA
CONVERSION
FACTOR
UNIT
STANDARD VALUE
OF TEST LIMIT
Time
$81
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
less than 0.05 V
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 0 and 80%
Time
$84
Percentage of monitoring time
where Oxygen Sensor voltage is
0.70 V or more
Multiply 0.3906
%
Between 20 and
100%
Time
$85
Maximum Rich (≥0.45 V) time
Multiply 0.2621
Second
Between 20 and
66.8 seconds
If all the values (Time $81, Time $84 and Time $85) are out of the standard values, the ECM
interprets this as a malfunction.
Page 43 of 43
Technical Service
BULLETIN
March 1, 2004
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
A/C COMPRESSOR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE
Models:
Applicable Models
Use the following tip when installing an A/C compressor on the AZ or ZZ series engine
to ensure proper belt alignment. Improper installation of the A/C compressor may result
in abnormal belt noise or wear.
S 1998 – Current model year Corolla vehicles.
S 2000 – Current model year Celica vehicles.
S 2000 – Current model year MR2 Spyder vehicles.
S 2001 – Current model year Highlander vehicles equipped with 4 cylinder engine.
S 2001 – Current model year RAV4 vehicles.
S 2002 – Current model year Camry vehicles equipped with 4 cylinder engine.
S 2002 – Current model year Solara vehicles equipped with 4 cylinder engine.
S 2003 – Current model year Matrix vehicles.
Warranty
Information
OP CODE
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
N/A
Not Applicable to Warranty
–
–
–
–
Installation
Procedure
Proper Installation
Improper Installation
Belt
Bolt
NG
OK
Clearance
A/C Compressor
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 2
HEATING & AIR CONDITIONING
AC003-04
Title:
A/C COMPRESSOR INSTALLATION PROCEDURE – AC003-04
Installation
Procedure
(Continued)
1. AZ Series Engine:
Install A/C Compressor
March 1, 2004
4 Bolt
3
Bolt
Push
A. Loosely install the compressor
(with the 3 bolts and nut or
4 bolts.)
Push down on the rear side of the
compressor and tighten the
bolts/nut in the order shown.
Torque: 24.5 NSm (250 kgfScm, 18 ftSlbf)
2
2. ZZ Series Engine:
Install A/C Compressor
Nut or Bolt
3 Bolt
1 Bolt
Push
A. Loosely install the compressor
(with the 2 bolts and nut or
3 bolts).
Push down on the rear side of
the compressor and tighten the
bolts/nut in the order shown.
Torque: 29 NSm (295 kgfScm, 21 ftSlbf)
2
Page 2 of 2
Nut or Bolt
1 Bolt
April 28, 2004
Applicable Avalon, Camry, Sienna & Solara
Introduction
Applicable
Vehicles
Models:
Some vehicles equipped with 1MZ–FE (V6) engines without VVTi may exhibit a rough
idle and/or a M.I.L. “ON” condition with a diagnostic trouble code or codes for misfire
caused by an improperly operating ignition coil assembly. Production changes have been
implemented to prevent this condition from occuring.
S 2001 model year Japan built Camry vehicles equipped with 1MZ–FE engines (V6).
S 1998–2001 model year North American built Camry vehicles equipped with
1MZ–FE engines (V6)
S 1998 – 1999 model year Avalon vehicles.
S 1998 – 2000 model year Sienna vehicles.
S 1999 – 2002 model year Solara vehicles equipped with 1MZ–FE engines produced
BEFORE the Production Change Effective VIN shown below.
Production
Change
Information
Warranty
Information
MODEL
ENGINE
PRODUCTION CHANGE EFFECTIVE VIN
Solara
1MZ–FE
2T1CF2#P*2C578710
OP CODE
MODEL
DESCRIPTION
TIME
OFP
T1
T2
191011
Avalon
R & R Ignition Coil (one coil)
0.2
90080–19012
02 73
191011
Camry
Solara
Sienna
R & R Ignition Coil (one coil)
03
0.3
90080 19012
90080–19012
02 73
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Federal Emissions Warranty. This warranty is
in effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle’s
in-service date.
For California specification vehicles registered and operated in California, Maine,
Massachusetts or Vermont, this repair is covered under the California Emissions
Warranty, which is in effect for 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from
the vehicle’s in-service date.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer’s specific complaint.
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 3
ENGINE
Technical Service
BULLETIN
M.I.L. ON" 1MZ-FE ENGINE MISFIRE
DTC P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303,
P0304, P0305 OR P0306
EG008-04
Title:
M.I.L. “ON” 1MZ–FE ENGINE MISFIRE DTC P0300 – P0306 – EG008-04
Parts
Information
Required
SSTs
April 28, 2004
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER
CURRENT PART NUMBER
PART NAME
QTY
90080–19012
Same
Ignition Coil Assembly
1
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS (SSTs)
PART NUMBER
QUANTITY
01001271
1
01002593-005
1
Toyota Diagnostic Tester Kit*
12 Megabyte Diagnostic Tester Program Card
with version 10.2a Software (or later)*
*
Essential SSTs.
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, Program Cards or other SSTs may be ordered by
calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Required
Tools &
Material
Repair
Procedure
TOOLS & MATERIAL
QUANTITY
Digital Volt Ohmmeter (DVOM)
1
1. Confirm if vehicle is currently misfiring, running rough or hesitating.
If YES – Go to Step 2.
If NO – Review Freeze Frame Data and attempt to operate vehicle under similar
driving conditions – see notes below for information that makes it more likely to
duplicate misfire.
NOTE:
The following activities will turn off misfire detection:
S Changing engine RPM greater than 150 RPM.
S Changing throttle position quickly.
Misfire duplication can be duplicated most readily when the engine speed and throttle
angle are held nearly constant for at least 2 minutes.
NOTE:
When misfire monitor is active, ignition value will change on Data List.
When pending misfire DTC is set, “MISFIRE RPM” and “MISFIRE LOAD” will show values.
Page 2 of 3
A
B
IGNITION
41
CYL #1
0%
CYL #2
0%
CYL #3
0%
CYL #4
Above 50%
CYL #5
0%
CYL #6
0%
MISFIRE RPM
0rpm
MISFIRE LOAD 0.00g/rev
# CODES
1
CHECK MODE
OFF
MISFIRE TEST
COMPL
IGNITION
205
CYL #1
0%
CYL #2
0%
CYL #3
0%
CYL #4
Above 50%
CYL #5
0%
CYL #6
0%
MISFIRE RPM
0rpm
MISFIRE LOAD 0.00g/rev
# CODES
1
CHECK MODE
OFF
MISFIRE TEST
COMPL
Values Will Change
From Zero
M.I.L. “ON” 1MZ–FE ENGINE MISFIRE DTC P0300 – P0306 – EG008-04
Repair
Procedure
(Continued)
April 28, 2004
2. Confirm if misfire is currently occurring on cylinder(s) identified by DTC(s) using the
Diagnostic Tester while engine is idling (see below).
Examining Data List For Misfire Percent
A
B
FUNCTION SELECT FOR
NORTH AMERICA
1: OBD/MOBD
2: ENHANCED OBD
3: CARB OBD II
4: BREAK–OUT BOX
5: NVH
6: AUTOPROBE
7: 02 RPM CHECK
8: SNAPSHOT REVIEW
9: SETUP
0: GAS ANALYSIS
NOTICE
ENHANCED OBDII
COVERS VEHICLES
THROUGH 2004MY.
EXCEPT SEQUOIA,
TUNDRA, TACOMA.
FOR OTHER VEHICLES
SELECT 2004 NEW
MODEL OR USE CARB
OBDII
PRESS [ENTER]
D
SELECT DATA
ALL
USER DATA
EXTEND DATA
MISFIRE
ATM
02 SENSOR
FUEL SYS
CATALYTIC
EVAP
C
DIAGNOSTIC MENU
ENGINE
1: DATA LIST
2: DTC INFO
3: ACTIVE TEST
4: SNAPSHOT
5: SYSTEM CHECK
6: RESET MEMORY
7: MONITOR STATUS
8: CHECK MODE
E
IGNITION
41
CYL #1
0%
CYL #2
0%
CYL #3
0%
CYL #4
Above 50%
CYL #5
0%
CYL #6
0%
MISFIRE RPM
0rpm
MISFIRE LOAD 0.00g/rev
# CODES
1
CHECK MODE
OFF
MISFIRE TEST
COMPL
Misfire on #4 Cylinder
Is the cylinder(s) identified by the DTC(s) misfiring?
If YES – Go to Step 3.
If NO – Follow normal diagnostics for applicable DTC in Technical Information System
(TIS) in applicable Repair Manual: Diagnostics: SFI: P030#.
3. Swap suspect ignition coil(s) from cylinder that is misfiring to cylinder that is
not misfiring.
4. Using Diagnostic Tester, confirm that misfire is now occurring in cylinder that has
suspect ignition coil(s). Has misfire followed swapped ignition coil(s)?
If YES – Replace ignition coil(s) and go to Step 5.
If NO – Follow normal diagnostics in Technical Information System (TIS) for
applicable Repair Manual: Diagnostics: SFI: P030#.
5. Confirm misfire has been eliminated (0% at all times) using Diagnostic Tester while
engine is idling.
NOTE:
If misfire percent is any value other than 0% at any time, then that cylinder is misfiring.
Page 3 of 3
Technical Service
BULLETIN
Models:
All Models
May 18, 2004
Introduction
Correction pages are available for the service publications listed below. This bulletin
summarizes service publication content changes that have been released between
February 2003 and March 2004. These changes have already been implemented in the
Toyota Technical Information System (TIS). For the most accurate service information
content, technicians are strongly encouraged to refer to TIS (http://tis.toyota.com ).
Internet access is also available to Toyota service information content by subscription
(http://techinfo.toyota.com ).
NOTE:
Inventory quantities of printed correction pages are limited, and part numbers are
obsolete when supplies are exhausted. When ordering a technical publication
(i.e., Repair Manual, Electrical Wiring Diagram) from the MDC, any correction page(s)
associated with that particular publication which were published at the time of
purchase will automatically be included with your order.
Parts
Information
Correction pages may be ordered from the Materials Distribution Center (MDC) through
Dealer Daily or by calling the MDC at 1–800–622–2033 using the corresponding part
numbers from the following table.
Publication
Number
Page(s)
Part Number
4Runner
2002 4Runner . . . . . . RM887–U2 . . .
2003 4Runner . . . . . . RM1034–U . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM1001–U1 . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM1001–U2 . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
BE–18, BE–19 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM887–3043B
14–31, 14–70, 14–85 . . . . 00400–RM103–2174
02–32 to 02–34 . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM100–3110
05–816, 05–817, . . . . . . 00400–RM100–3162
05–817–1, 05–817–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
03–46, 05–449 . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM100–3194
11–21–1 to 11–21–4 . . . 00400–RM100–2172B
27–15, 27–16 . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM100–3025B
73–23, 73–26 . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM100–3103B
30–38 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM100–3110B
27–7, 27–30, 27–35 . . . 00400–RM100–3239B
Avalon
2002 Avalon . . . . . . . . RM872–U2 . . .
2003 Avalon . . . . . . . . EWD487–U . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM953–U2 . . .
...................................
...................................
BE–23, BE–24 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM872–3080B
209 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD48–3183
BE–4 to BE–6 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM953–2164B
BE–102 to BE–105 . . . . 00400–RM953–2196B
BE–23, BE–24 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM953–3088B
Toyota Supports ASE Certification
Page 1 of 5
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX
PG003-04
Title:
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG003-04
Publication
Number
May 18, 2004
Page(s)
Part Number
Camry
1997 Camry . . . . . . . . RM503–U2 . . .
2000 Camry . . . . . . . . RM742–U2 . . .
2002 Camry . . . . . . . . EWD461–U . . .
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM881–U1 . . .
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM881–U2 . . .
...................................
...................................
2003 Camry . . . . . . . . RM972–U1 . . .
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM972–U2 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM1026–U . . .
Celica
2004 Celica . . . . . . . . . RM1066–U1 . . DI–380 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM106–3307
Corolla
ECHO
Highlander
Land Cruiser
Page 2 of 5
2003 Corolla . . . . . . . . RM938–U1 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
BE–69 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM503–2218B
BE–70 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM742–2221B
38, 78, 289, . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD46–2181
Overall M:5 (cont’d) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–894, 05–895, . . . . . . 00400–RM881–3158
05–895–1, 05–895–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
12–10, 12–20 . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM881–3086B
14–57 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM881–3142B
33–3, 33–7, 33–14 . . . . 00400–RM881–3245B
05–1008, 05–1009, . . . . 00400–RM972–3160
05–1009–1, 05–1009–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
73–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM972–2183B
12–9, 12–19 . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM972–3087B
14–54 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM972–3141B
33–3, 33–7, 33–14 . . . . 00400–RM972–3246B
73–1, 73–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM102–3101
05–484 to 05–487 . . . . . . 00400–RM938–2160
05–421, 05–422, . . . . . . 00400–RM938–3155
05–422–1, 05–422–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–40 to 05–42, . . . . . . . 00400–RM938–3236
05–112, 05–113 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
2002 ECHO . . . . . . . . RM884–U . . . . DI–108 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM884–3203
2003 ECHO . . . . . . . . RM984–U . . . . DI–154 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM984–3204
2002 Highlander . . . . RM918–U1 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM918–U2 . . .
2003 Highlander . . . . RM987–U1 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM987–U2 . . .
...................................
05–943, 05–962–1 . . . . 00400–RM918–3108B
05–710, 05–711, . . . . . . 00400–RM918–3156
05–711–1, 05–711–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
03–47 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM918–3232
32–24, 32–28 . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM918–3232B
14–56 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM918–3144B
05–1028, 05–1047–1 . . . 00400–RM100–3109
05–788, 05–789, . . . . . . 00400–RM987–3153
05–789–1, 05–789–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
03–47 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM987–3233
73–11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM987–2184B
14–51 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM881–3143B
1999 Land Cruiser . . . RM661–U2 . . . BE–28, BE–29 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM661–3057B
2002 Land Cruiser . . . RM893–U2 . . . BE–28, BE–29 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM722–3060B
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG003-04
Publication
Land Cruiser
(Continued)
Matrix
Number
2003 Land Cruiser . . . EWD510–U . . .
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM966–U1 . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM966–U2 . . .
...................................
May 18, 2004
Page(s)
Part Number
71, 84, 85, 96, 97, . . . . . 00400–EWD51–2195
244, 245, 383, 387, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
388, 396, Overall M:24 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SS–23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM966–3195
BE–95 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM966–2185B
BE–34, BE–35 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM966–3061B
2003 Matrix . . . . . . . . . . . RM940–U1 . . . .
......................................
......................................
......................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM940–U2 . . . .
05–710, 05–711, . . . 00400–RM940–3154
05–711–1, 05–711–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–89, 05–95, . . . . . . 00400–RM940–3275
05–241, 05–247 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
65–7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM940–2205B
MR2 Spyder
2001 MR2 Spyder . . . EWD424–U . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM801–U . . . .
...................................
2002 MR2 Spyder . . . RM900–U . . . .
...................................
2003 MR2 Spyder . . . RM967–U1 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM967–U2 . . .
61, Overall M:2 . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD42–2214
DI–180 to DI–188, . . . . . . 00400–RM801–2192
DI–188–1, DI–188–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BR–17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM900–1143
DI–189 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM900–2190
DI–245 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM967–2189
SS–35 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM967–3006
DI–121, DI–128, . . . . . . . 00400–RM967–3278
DI–134, DI–156 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–3, SA–5, SA–7 . . . . 00400–RM967–3006B
Prius
2001 Prius . . . . . . . . . . RM778–U1 . . .
2002 Prius . . . . . . . . . . RM883–U1 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
2003 Prius . . . . . . . . . . RM957–U1 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
2004 Prius . . . . . . . . . . EWD555–U . . .
...................................
...................................
DI–671 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM778–2095R
DI–762, 766 to 769, . . . 00400–RM883–2224
774, 777 to 780, 782, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
785 to 792, 794, 796 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–337 to DI–344 . . . . . . 00400–RM883–3241
DI–762, 766 to 769, . . . . 00400–RM957–2223
774, 777 to 780, 782, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
785 to 792, 794, 796 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–337 to DI–344 . . . . . . 00400–RM957–3242
20, 22, 23, 194, . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD55–3296
293, 297, 306, 343, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Overall 4–1, 11–5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
RAV4
2002 RAV4 . . . . . . . . . RM891–U1 . . . DI–18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM891–3091
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM891–U2 . . . BR–21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM891–1142B
Sequoia
2002 Sequoia . . . . . . . RM886–U1 . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM886–U2 . . .
2003 Sequoia . . . . . . . EWD495–U . . .
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM959–U1 . . .
...................................
IN–17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM886–3309
BE–54 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM886–3096B
37, 246, Overall M:24 . . . 00400–EWD49–2213
199, Overall M:15–4 . . . . . . 00400–EWD49–5U
PP–55 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–2125
DI–605 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–2179
Page 3 of 5
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG003-04
Publication
Number
May 18, 2004
Page(s)
Part Number
Sequoia
(Continued)
2003 Sequoia . . . . . . . RM959–U1 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM959–U2 . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
2004 Sequoia . . . . . . . EWD541–U . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM1089–U1 . .
...................................
...................................
DI–600, DI–602 to . . . . . 00400–RM959–2204
DI–605, DI–608 to DI–610 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–308, DI–328 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–2206
PP–52 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3137
DI–329 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3179
DI–128, DI–129, . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3271
DI–135, DI–136, DI–142, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
DI–143, DI–163, DI–164 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
PP–35 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3228
SS–38 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3260
IN–17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3310
DI–300, DI–304, . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3311
DI–404 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
SA–98 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–2125B
BE–140 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–2179B
SR–12, BE–24 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–2206B
BE–58 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3094B
SA–90 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM959–3137B
199, Overall M:15–4 . . . . 00400–EWD54–3214
IN–17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM108–3312
DI–446, DI–450, . . . . . . . 00400–RM108–3313
DI–550 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Sienna
2002 Sienna . . . . . . . . RM871–U2 . . .
...................................
2003 Sienna . . . . . . . . EWD490–U . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM954–U2 . . .
...................................
2004 Sienna . . . . . . . . EWD524–U . . .
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM1025–U1 . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM1025–U2 . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
BE–23, BE–24 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM871–3081B
SR–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM871–3132B
193 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD49–3208
SR–3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM954–3133B
BE–23, BE–24 . . . . . . . . 00400–RM954–3082B
96, 97, 126, . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD52–3184
127, Overall M:1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–304, 05–355, . . . . . . 00400–RM102–3126
05–359 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
05–865, 05–866, . . . . . . 00400–RM102–3163
05–866–1, 05–866–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
73–23, 73–26 . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM102–3102B
14–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM102–3134B
28–2, 28–3, 28–4 . . . . . 00400–RM102–3135B
82–3 to 82–6, . . . . . . . . 00400–RM102–3186B
82–6–1, 82–6–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Solara
2003 Solara . . . . . . . . RM955–U1 . . . DI–287 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM955–3219
2004 Solara . . . . . . . . EWD554–U . . . 168 to 170, . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD554–3294
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overall M:15–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
Page 4 of 5
REPAIR MANUAL CORRECTIONS INDEX – PG003-04
Publication
Tacoma
Tundra
Number
May 18, 2004
Page(s)
Part Number
2002 Tacoma . . . . . . . RM921–U2 . . . BE–40 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM921–3084B
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM921–U1 . . . DI–323 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM921–3218
2003 Tacoma . . . . . . . RM1002–U2 . . BE–40 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM100–3085B
2002 Tundra . . . . . . . . RM885–U2 . . .
2003 Tundra . . . . . . . . EWD491–U . . .
...................................
...................................
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM956–U1 . . .
...................................
...................................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RM956–U2 . . .
2004 Tundra . . . . . . . . EWD567–U . . .
...................................
...................................
BE–52 to BE–56 . . . . . . 00400–RM885–3105B
139, 240, . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD49–12136
Overall M:30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
31, 33, 235, 261, . . . . . . 00400–EWD49–2216
Overall M:29 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
176, Overall M:18–5 . . . . 00400–EWD49–3210
SS–79 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–RM956–3258
DI–115, DI–117, . . . . . . . 00400–RM956–3282
DI–316, DI–318 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
BE–57 to BE–60 . . . . . . 00400–RM956–3106B
230, 446, . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00400–EWD56–3209
Overall M:19–5, M:49–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ↓
21, 94, 210, 515 . . . . . . . 00400–EWD56–3298
Page 5 of 5
BR–1
BRAKE
–
BRAKE SYSTEM
BRAKE SYSTEM
BR0A9–01
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
3.
Care must be taken to replace each part properly as it could affect the performance of the brake
system and result in a driving hazard. Replace the parts with parts having the same part number
or equivalent.
It is very important to keep parts and the area clean when repairing the brake system.
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precautions in the
IN section.
Author:
Date:
2024
BR–2
BRAKE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
BR0AA–03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
CAUSE
PAGE
1. Fluid leaks for brake system
2. Air in brake system
3. Piston seals (Worn or damaged)
Low pedal or spongy pedal
4. Rear brake shoe clearance (Out of adjustment)
5. Master cylinder (Faulty)
6. Booster push rod (Out of adjustment)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Brake pedal freeplay (Minimal)
Parking brake lever travel (Out of adjustment)
Parking brake wire (Sticking)
Rear brake shoe clearance (Out of adjustment)
Pad or lining (Cracked or distorted)
6. Piston (Stuck)
Brake drag
7. Piston (Frozen)
8. Anchor, return or tension spring (Faulty)
9. Booster push rod (Out of adjustment)
10.Vacuum leaks for booster system
11.Master cylinder (Faulty)
1. Piston (Stuck)
3. Piston (Frozen)
4. Disc (Scored)
5. Pad or lining (Cracked or distorted)
Author:
BR–5
BR–8
BR–35
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–24
BR–31
BR–39
BR–24
BR–31
BR–39
BR–31
BR–45
BR–20
BR–18
BR–9
BR–24
BR–31
BR–39
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–24
BR–31
BR–39
BR–24
BR–39
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
2. Pad or lining (Oily)
Brake pull
DI–536
BR–4
BR–24
BR–31
BR–39
BR–35
BR–9
BR–20
Date:
2025
BR–3
BRAKE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
1. Fluid leaks for brake system
2. Air in brake system
3. Pad or lining (Worn)
4. Pad or lining (Cracked or distorted)
Hard pedal but brake inefficient
5. Rear brake shoe clearance (Out of adjustment)
6. Pad or lining (Oily)
7. Pad or lining (Glazed)
8. Disc (Scored)
9. Booster push rod (Out of adjustment)
10.Vacuum leaks for booster system
1. Pad or lining (Cracked or distorted)
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–24
BR–39
BR–24
BR–39
BR–21
BR–36
BR–24
BR–39
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–31
BR–45
BR–21
BR–36
BR–31
BR–45
2. Installation bolt (Loose)
3. Disc (Scored)
4. Pad support plate (Loose)
5. Sliding pin (Worn)
Noise from brakes
6. Pad or lining (Dirty)
7. Pad or lining (Glazed)
8. Anchor, return or tension spring (Faulty)
9. Anti–squeal shim (Damaged)
10.Shoe hold–down spring (Damaged)
Author:
DI–536
BR–4
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–35
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–21
BR–31
BR–36
BR–24
BR–39
BR–20
BR–18
Date:
2026
BR–4
BRAKE
–
BRAKE FLUID
BRAKE FLUID
BR0AB–03
BLEEDING
F05595
F05596
HINT:
If any work is done on the brake system or if air is suspected in
the brake lines, bleed the air from the system.
NOTICE:
Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted surface. Wash it
off immediately.
1.
FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
Check the fluid level in the reservoir after bleeding each wheel.
Add fluid, if necessary.
Fluid: SAEJ1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3
2.
BLEED MASTER CYLINDER
HINT:
If the master cylinder has been disassembled or if the reservoir
becomes empty, bleed the air from the master cylinder.
(a) Disconnect the 2 brake lines from the master cylinder.
(b) Slowly depress the brake pedal and hold it.
(c)
(d)
Block off the outlet plugs with your fingers, and release
the brake pedal.
Repeat (b) and (c) 3 or 4 times.
F05597
3.
R00252
CONNECT VINYL TUBE TO BRAKE CALIPER OR
WHEEL CYLINDER BLEEDER PLUG
Insert the other end of the tube in a half–full container of brake
fluid.
NOTICE:
Bleed air of the rear brake first. If front brake is bled first,
rear brake air cannot be bled.
4.
BLEED BRAKE LINE
(a) Slowly depress the brake pedal several times.
(b) While an assistant depresses the pedal, loosen the
bleeder plug until fluid starts to run out. Then tighten the
bleeder plug.
(c) Repeat this procedure until there are no more air bubbles
in the fluid.
Torque: (Bleeder plug)
8.3 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
5.
REPEAT PROCEDURE FOR EACH WHEEL
Author:
Date:
2027
BR–5
BRAKE
–
BRAKE PEDAL
BRAKE PEDAL
Stop Light
Switch
BR0YH–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
Push Rod
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
Pedal Height
R00954
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
3.
(a)
Pedal Freeplay
R00935
(b)
CHECK PEDAL HEIGHT
Pedal height from asphalt sheet:
152.0 – 162.0 mm (5.984 – 6.378 in.)
IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PEDAL HEIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the stop light switch.
Loosen the stop light switch lock nut and remove the stop
light switch.
Loosen the push rod lock nut.
Adjust the pedal height by turning the pedal push rod.
Tighten the push rod lock nut.
Torque: 25 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
Install the stop light switch and turn it until it lightly contacts the pedal stopper.
Push in the brake pedal 5–15 mm (0.20–0.59 in.), turn the
stop light switch to lock the nut in the position where the
stop light goes off.
Connect the connector to the stop light switch.
After installation, push in the brake pedal 5–15 mm
(0.20–0.59 in.), check that stop light lights up.
Connect the connector to the stop light switch.
After adjusting the pedal height, check the pedal freeplay.
CHECK PEDAL FREEPLAY
Stop the engine and depress the brake pedal several
times until there is no more vacuum left in the booster.
Push in the pedal by hand until the resistance begins to
be felt, then measure the distance.
Pedal freeplay: 1 – 6 mm (0.04 – 0.24 in.)
HINT:
The freeplay to the 1st resistance is due to the play between the
clevis and pin. This is magnified up to 1 – 6 mm (0.04 – 0.24 in.)
at the pedal.
If incorrect, check the stop light switch clearance.
If the clearance is OK, then troubleshoot the brake system.
Stop light switch clearance:
0.5 – 2.4 mm (0.020 – 0.094 in.)
Author:
Date:
2028
BR–6
BRAKE
Pedal Reserve Distance
–
BRAKE PEDAL
4.
(a)
(b)
CHECK PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE
Release the parking brake.
With the engine running, depress the pedal and measure
the pedal reserve distance, as shown.
Pedal reserve distance from asphalt sheet at 490 N
(50 kgf, 110.2 lbf): More than 70 mm (2.76 in.)
If the reserve distance is incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system.
R00934
Author:
Date:
2029
BR–7
BRAKE
–
BRAKE PEDAL
BR0YI–01
COMPONENTS
A/T:
Lower Panel Insert
Wave Washer
No.1 Lower Panel
Clevis Pin
Brake Pedal Bracket
Stop Light Switch
Cruise Control ECU
13 (130, 9)
Clip
5.0 (51, 44 in.·lbf)
Bushing
Front Opening Cover
13 (130, 9)
M/T:
Return Spring
39 (400, 29)
Bushing
Collar
Pedal Pad
Cushion Plate
Pedal Pad
Brake Pedal
Brake Pedal
Cowl Side Trim
Inside Scuff Plate
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
F07004
Author:
Date:
2030
BR–8
BRAKE
–
PARKING BRAKE LEVER
PARKING BRAKE LEVER
BR0AD–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
W03254
Lock Nut
Adjusting Nut
W03255
1.
CHECK THAT PARKING BRAKE LEVER TRAVEL
Pull the parking brake lever all the way up, and count the number of clicks.
Parking brake lever travel at 196 N (20 kgf, 44.1 lbf):
5 – 8 clicks
If incorrect, adjust the parking brake.
2.
IF NECESSARY, ADJUST PARKING BRAKE LEVER
TRAVEL
HINT:
Before adjusting the parking brake lever travel, make sure that
the rear brake shoe clearance has been adjusted. For shoe
clearance adjustment, see step 2 on page BR–35 or step 1 on
page BR–48.
(a) Remove the console box.
(b) Loosen the lock nut and adjust the adjusting nut until the
lever travel is correct.
(c) Tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
(d) Install the console box.
Author:
Date:
2031
BR–9
BRAKE
–
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR0AE–02
COMPONENTS
w/o ABS
Brake Booster
Master Cylinder
15 (155, 11)
w/ ABS (& TRAC)
2–way
Gasket
3–way
13 (130, 9)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z19120
w/ TRAC
Cap
Strainer
Reservoir Set Screw
1.7 (18, 16 in.·lbf)
Straight Pin
Reservoir
Grommet
Spring
Spring
Grommet
No. 1 Piston
No. 2 Piston
Cylinder Body
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Lithium soap base glycol grease
W03569
Author:
Date:
2032
BR–10
BRAKE
–
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
w/o ABS
Cap
Strainer
Reservoir
Reservoir Set Screw
1.7 (18, 16 in.·lbf)
Snap Ring
Grommet
Grommet
No. 2 Piston and Spring
Gasket
No. 1 Piston and Spring
Cylinder Body
10 (100, 7)
Stopper Bolt
Cap
w/ ABS
Strainer
Reservoir
Reservoir Set Screw
1.7 (18, 16 in.·lbf)
Snap Ring
Grommet
Grommet
No. 2 Piston and Spring
Cylinder Body
No. 1 Piston and Spring
Gasket
10 (100, 7)
Stopper Bolt
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
Z19122
Author:
Date:
2033
BR–11
BRAKE
–
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR0AF–03
REMOVAL
1.
SST
W04697
R11405
DISCONNECT LEVEL WARNING SWITCH CONNECTOR
2.
TAKE OUT FLUID WITH SYRINGE
NOTICE:
Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted surface. Wash it
off immediately.
3.
DISCONNECT BRAKE LINES
(a) w/ ABS (& TRAC):
Using SST, disconnect the 4 brake lines.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
(b) w/o ABS:
Using SST, disconnect the 5 brake lines.
SST 09023–00100
Torque: 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
4.
REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER
Remove the 2 nuts, and pull out the 2 or 3–way, master cylinder
and gasket.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2034
BR–12
BRAKE
–
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR0AG–02
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
3.
REMOVE RESERVOIR
Remove the set screw and pull out the reservoir.
Torque: 1.7 N·m (18 kgf·cm, 16 in.·lbf)
Remove the cap and strainer from the reservoir.
REMOVE 2 GROMMETS
Except w/ TRAC:
PLACE CYLINDER IN VISE
4.
w/o TRAC:
REMOVE PISTON STOPPER BOLT
Using a screwdriver, push the pistons in all the way and remove
the piston stopper bolt and gasket.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Soft Jows
R11406
5.
Soft Jows
(a)
R11407
w/o TRAC:
REMOVE 2 PISTONS AND SPRINGS
Push in the piston with a screwdriver and remove the
snap ring with snap ring pliers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the No. 1 piston and spring by hand, pulling
straight out, not at an angle.
NOTICE:
If pulled out and installed at an angle, there is a possibility that the cylinder bore could be damaged.
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Be careful not to damage the rubber lips on the pistons.
(c)
Place a rag and 2 wooden blocks on the work table, and
lightly tap the cylinder flange against the block edges until
the No. 2 piston drops out of the cylinder.
HINT:
Make sure that the distance (A) from the rag to the top of the
blocks is at least 100 mm (3.94 in.).
A
R12236
Author:
Date:
2035
BR–13
BRAKE
6.
(a)
–
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
w/ TRAC:
REMOVE 2 PISTONS AND SPRINGS
Push in the piston with a screwdriver, and remove the 2
straight pins by turning over the cylinder body.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 pistons and springs by hand, pulling
straight out, not at an angle.
W03570
NOTICE:
If pulled out and installed at an angle, there is a possibility that the cylinder bore could be damaged.
At the time of reassembly, be careful not to damage
the rubber lips on the pistons.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, insert the pistons with elliptic hole
facing vertically.
W03590
Author:
Date:
2036
BR–14
BRAKE
–
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR0AH–01
INSPECTION
HINT:
Clean the disassembled parts with compressed air.
1.
INSPECT CYLINDER BORE FOR RUST OR SCORING
2.
INSPECT CYLINDER FOR WEAR OR DAMAGE
If necessary, clean or replace the cylinder.
Author:
Date:
2037
BR–15
BRAKE
–
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR0AI–02
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BR–12).
NOTICE:
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the rubber parts indicated by the arrows
(See page BR–9).
Author:
Date:
2038
BR–16
BRAKE
–
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR0AJ–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BR–11).
HINT:
Before installation, adjust length of the brake booster push rod (See page BR–20).
After installation, fill the brake reservoir with brake fluid, bleed the brake system and check for leaks
(See page BR–4).
Check and adjust brake pedal (See page BR–5).
Author:
Date:
2039
BR–17
BRAKE
–
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSEMBLY
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSEMBLY
BR0AK–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
BR2237
GOOD
NO GOOD
3rd
1st
2nd
BR2238
OPERATING CHECK
Depress the brake pedal several times with the engine off
and check that there is no change in the pedal reserve
distance.
Depress the brake pedal and start the engine. If the pedal
goes down slightly, operation is normal.
2.
(a)
AIR TIGHTNESS CHECK
Start the engine and stop it after 1 or 2 minutes. Depress
the brake pedal several times slowly.
If the pedal goes down farthest the 1st time, but gradually rises
after the 2nd or 3rd time, the booster is air tight.
(b) Depress the brake pedal while the engine is running, and
stop the engine with the pedal depressed. If there is no
change in the pedal reserve travel after holding the pedal
for 30 seconds, the booster is air tight.
Author:
Date:
2040
BR–18
BRAKE
–
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSEMBLY
BR0AL–03
COMPONENTS
Brake Booster
Master Cylinder
w/ ABS (& TRAC)
15 (155, 11)
Gasket
Pin
Gasket
Clip
2–way
3–way
25 (260, 19)
Clevis
13 (130, 9)
13 (130, 9)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Z19121
Author:
Date:
2041
BR–19
BRAKE
–
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSEMBLY
BR0AM–03
REMOVAL
1.
5.
6.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER COVER WITH AIR CLEANER
HOSE
REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER (See page BR–11)
REMOVE CHARCOL CANISTER
DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSE FROM BRAKE
BOOSTER
REMOVE PEDAL RETURN SPRING
REMOVE CLIP AND CLEVIS PIN
7.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE BRAKE BOOSTER, GASKET AND CLEVIS
Remove the 4 nuts and clevis.
Pull out the brake booster and gasket.
2.
3.
4.
F06431
Author:
Date:
2042
BR–20
BRAKE
–
BRAKE BOOSTER ASSEMBLY
BR0AN–03
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
2.
(a)
(b)
SST
Gasket
(c)
F03521
SST
(d)
(e)
3.
4.
5.
R11347
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
INSTALL BRAKE BOOSTER
Install the booster and a new gasket.
Install the clevis to the operating rod.
Install and torque the booster installation nuts.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Install the clevis, and torque the lock nut.
Torque: 25 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
Install the clevis pin into the clevis and brake pedal, and
install the clip to the clevis pin.
Install the pedal return spring.
ADJUST LENGTH OF BOOSTER PUSH ROD
Install a new gasket on the master cylinder.
Set the SST on the gasket, and lower the pin until its tip
slightly touches the piston.
SST 09737–00010
Turn the SST upside down, and set it on the booster.
SST 09737–00010
Measure the clearance between the booster push rod
and pin head (SST).
Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.)
Adjust the booster push rod length until the push rod lightly touches the pin head.
INSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER TO ORIGINAL POSITION
INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER (See page BR–16)
INSTALL AIR CLEANER COVER WITH AIR CLEANER
HOSE
CONNECT VACUUM HOSE TO BRAKE BOOSTER
FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID AND
BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM (See page BR–4)
CHECK FOR FLUID LEAKAGE
CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL
(See page BR–5)
DO OPERATIONAL CHECK (See page BR–17)
Author:
Date:
2043
BR–21
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE PAD
FRONT BRAKE PAD
BR0AO–03
COMPONENTS
5S–FE engine:
34 (350, 25)
Anti–squeal Shim
Inner Anti–squeal Shim
Anti–squeal Spring
Outer Pad
Pad Support Plate
Inner Pad
1MZ–FE engine:
34 (350, 25)
Anti–squeal Shim
Inner Anti–squeal Shim
Pad Wear Indicator Plate
Outer Pad
Pad Support Plate
Inner Pad
F07224
F06983
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
Disc brake grease
F07225
Author:
Date:
2044
BR–22
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE PAD
BR0AP–03
REPLACEMENT
F07213
R02874
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Remove the wheel and temporarily fasten the disc with hub
nuts.
2.
INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Check the pad thickness through the caliper inspection hole
and replace the pads if they are not within the specification.
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3.
LIFT UP CALIPER
(a) Remove the bolt and flexible hose from the bracket.
(b) 5S–FE engine:
Hold the sliding pin on the bottom and loosen the installation bolt, and remove the installation bolt.
(c) 1MZ–FE engine:
Remove the bottom side installation bolt.
(d) Lift up the caliper and suspend it securely.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
4.
5S–FE engine:
REMOVE 2 ANTI–SQUEAL SPRINGS
5.
REMOVE 2 BRAKE PADS
6.
REMOVE 4 ANTI–SQUEAL SHIMS
7.
1MZ–FE engine:
REMOVE PAD WEAR INDICATOR PLATE
8.
1MZ–FE engine:
REMOVE 2 PAD SUPPORT PLATES
9.
5S–FE engine:
REMOVE 4 PAD SUPPORT PLATES
NOTICE:
The anti–squeal springs and support plates can be used
again provided that they have sufficient rebound, no deformation, cracks or wear, and have had all rust, dirt and
foreign particles cleaned off.
10. CHECK DISC THICKNESS AND RUNOUT
(See page BR–28)
11. INSTALL 2 OR 4 PAD SUPPORT PLATES
12. INSTALL NEW PADS
NOTICE:
When replacing worn pads, the anti–squeal shims and
wear indicator plates must be replaced together with the
pads.
Author:
Date:
2045
BR–23
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE PAD
(a)
R00595
1MZ–FE engine:
Install a pad wear indicator plate on the inner pad.
(b) Apply disc brake grease to both sides of the inner anti–
squeal shims (See page BR–21).
(c) Install the 2 anti–squeal shims on each pad.
(d) Install inner pad with the pad wear indicator plate facing
upward.
(e) Install inner pad.
(f)
Install outer pad.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease adhering to the friction
surfaces of the pads or the disc.
(g) 5S–FE engine:
Install the 2 anti–squeal springs.
13.
(a)
(b)
R02981
INSTALL CALIPER
Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the reservoir.
Press in the piston with a hammer handle or similar implement.
HINT:
If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the bleeder plug and
push in the piston while letting some brake fluid escape.
(c) Install the caliper.
(d) 5S–FE engine:
Hold the sliding pin and torque the installation bolt.
(e) 1MZ–FE engine:
Install the installation bolt.
Torque: 34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
(f)
Install the flexible hose and bolt to the bracket.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
14. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
15. DEPRESS BRAKE PEDAL SEVERAL TIMES
16. CHECK THAT FLUID LEVEL IS AT MAX LINE
Author:
Date:
2046
BR–24
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
BR0AQ–02
COMPONENTS
5S–FE engine:
Caliper
Torque Plate
29 (300, 21)
107 (1,090, 79)
34 (350, 25)
Disc
Bleeder Plug
8.3 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
29 (300, 21)
Gasket
Sliding Pin
Dust Boot
Piston
Piston Seal
Boot
Set Ring
Sliding Pin
Pad Support Plate
Sliding Bushing
Dust Boot
Anti–squeal Shim
Anti–squeal Spring
Outer Pad
Inner Anti–squeal Shim
Inner Pad
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
Disc brake grease
F07212
Author:
Date:
2047
BR–25
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
1MZ–FE engine:
Caliper
29 (300, 21)
107 (1,090, 79)
Torque Plate
34 (350, 25)
Disc
Bleeder Plug
8.3 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
29 (300, 21)
Gasket
Sliding pin
Sliding Bushing
Piston
Dust Boot
Set Ring
Piston Seal
Boot
Sliding Pin
Pad Support Plate
Dust Boot
Pad Wear Indicator Plate
Inner Pad
Outer Pad
Inner Anti–squeal Shim
Anti–squeal Shim
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
Disc Brake grease
F07226
Author:
Date:
2048
BR–26
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
BR0AR–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
R02840
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1.050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper,
then disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Install the flexible hose lock securely in the lock hole in the caliper.
(b) Use a container to catch the brake fluid as it drains out.
3.
REMOVE CALIPER
(a) 5S–FE engine:
Hold the sliding pin and loosen the 2 installation bolts, and
remove the installation bolts.
(b) 1MZ–FE engine:
Remove the 2 installation bolts.
Torque: 34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
4.
5S–FE engine:
REMOVE 2 ANTI–SQUEAL SPRINGS
5.
REMOVE 2 BRAKE PADS WITH ANTI–SQUEAL
SHIMS
6.
1MZ–FE engine:
REMOVE 2 PAD SUPPORT PLATES
7.
5S–FE engine:
REMOVE 4 PAD SUPPORT PLATES
Author:
Date:
2049
BR–27
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
BR0AS–03
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SET RING AND CYLINDER BOOT
Using a screwdriver, remove the set ring and cylinder boot from
the caliper.
R00121
2.
(a)
REMOVE PISTON
Place a piece of cloth or similar, between the piston and
the caliper.
(b) Use compressed air to remove the piston from the cylinder.
CAUTION:
Do not place your fingers in front of the piston when using
compressed air.
R00122
3.
REMOVE PISTON SEAL
Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from the cylinder.
R00123
R02877
4.
REMOVE SLIDING PINS AND DUST BOOTS
(a) Remove the 2 sliding pins from the torque plate.
NOTICE:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following
item.
Insert the sliding pin with sliding bushing into the bottom
side (5S–FE engine) or top side (1MZ–FE engine).
(b) Using a screwdriver and hammer, tap out the 2 dust
boots.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Use a 22 mm (5S–FE engine) or 24 mm (1MZ–FE engine) socket wrench and tap in 2 new dust boots into the torque plate.
NOTICE:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following
item.
Check that the metal plate portion of the dust boot fits
snugly in the torque plate.
Author:
Date:
2050
BR–28
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
BR0AT–03
INSPECTION
F06988
1.
MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
5S–FE engine: 12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
1MZ–FE engine: 11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Replace the pad if the pad’s thickness is at the minimum thickness or less, or if the pad has severe and uneven wear.
2.
MEASURE DISC THICKNESS
Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness: 28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Minimum thickness: 26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
Replace the disc if the disc’s thickness is at the minimum thickness or less. Replace the disc or grind it on a lathe if it is badly
scored or worn unevenly.
R02878
R02879
3.
MEASURE DISC RUNOUT
Using a dial indicator, measure disc runout 10 mm (0.39 in.)
away from the outer edge of the disc.
Maximum disc runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the disc’s runout is the maximum value or greater, check the
bearing play in the axial direction and check the axle hub runout
(See page SA–10). If the bearing play and axle hub runout are
not abnormal, adjust the disc runout or grind it on a ”On–Car”
brake lathe.
4.
(a)
(b)
R02880
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
IF NECESSARY, ADJUST DISC RUNOUT
Remove the torque plate from the knuckle.
Remove the hub nuts and the disc. Reinstall the disc in
the position turned 1/5 from its original position on the
hub. Install and torque the hub nuts.
Remeasure the disc runout. Make a note of the runout
and the disc’s position on the hub.
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
Repeat (b) until the disc has been installed on the 3 remaining hub positions.
If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is less than
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), install the disc in that position.
If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is greater
than 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.), replace the disc and repeat
step 3.
Install the torque plate and torque the mounting bolts.
Torque: 107 N·m (1,090 kgf·cm, 79 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2051
BR–29
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
BR0AU–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BR–27).
NOTICE:
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the parts indicated by arrows (See page BR–24).
Author:
Date:
2052
BR–30
BRAKE
–
FRONT BRAKE CALIPER
BR0AV–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BR–26).
HINT:
After installation, fill the brake reservoir with brake fluid, bleed the brake system (See page BR–4).
Check for leaks.
Author:
Date:
2053
BR–31
BRAKE
–
REAR DRUM BRAKE
REAR DRUM BRAKE
BR0AW–03
COMPONENTS
Bleeder Plug
Plug
Adjuster
8.3 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
10 (100, 7)
Wheel Cylinder
Spring
Boot
Inspection Hole
Plug
Cup
C–washer
Parking Brake Lever
Piston
Automatic Adjusting Lever
E–ring
Pin
Adjuster
Rear Shoe
Adjusting Lever Spring
Front Shoe
Anchor Spring
Cup
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
High temperature grease
Shoe Hold–down Spring
W03258
Author:
Date:
2054
BR–32
BRAKE
–
REAR DRUM BRAKE
BR0AX–03
REMOVAL
1.
INSPECT SHOE LINING THICKNESS
Remove the inspection hole plug, and check the shoe lining
thickness through the hole.
If less than the minimum, replace the shoes.
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
2.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
BR1532
3.
(a)
R00285
REMOVE BRAKE DRUM
Release the parking brake lever and remove the brake
drum.
HINT:
If the brake drum cannot be removed easily, do the following
steps.
(b) Insert a bent wire or equivalent through the hole in the
brake drum, and hold the automatic adjusting lever away
from the adjuster.
(c) Using a screwdriver, reduce the brake shoe adjustment
by turning the adjuster.
4.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT SHOE
Using SST, disconnect the return spring.
SST 09703–30010
(b)
Using SST, remove the shoe hold–down spring, 2 cups
and pin.
SST 09718–00010
Disconnect the anchor spring from the front shoe and remove the front shoe.
Remove the anchor spring from the rear shoe.
SST
BR1534
(c)
(d)
SST
BR1535
Author:
Date:
2055
BR–33
BRAKE
–
REAR DRUM BRAKE
5.
(a)
SST
R00248
Z03633
REMOVE REAR SHOE
Using SST, remove the shoe hold–down spring, 2 cups
and pin.
SST 09718–00010
(b) Using a screwdriver, disconnect the parking brake cable
from the anchor plate.
(c) Using pliers, disconnect the parking brake cable from the
lever and remove the rear shoe together with adjuster.
NOTICE:
Do not allow oil or grease on the rubbing face.
6.
REMOVE ADJUSTER FROM REAR SHOE
(a) Remove the adjusting lever spring.
(b) Remove the adjuster together with the return spring.
7.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC ADJUSTING LEVER AND
PARKING BRAKE LEVER
(a) Remove the E–ring.
(b) Remove the automatic adjusting lever.
(c) Remove the C–washer.
(d) Remove the parking brake lever.
8.
(a)
SST
(b)
BR1540
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE WHEEL CYLINDER
Using SST, disconnect the brake line. Use a container to
catch the brake fluid.
Torque: 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
SST 09751–36011
Remove the 2 bolts and the wheel cylinder.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
DISASSEMBLE WHEEL CYLINDER
Remove the 2 boots.
Remove the 2 pistons and springs.
Remove the 2 piston cups.
Author:
Date:
2056
BR–34
BRAKE
–
REAR DRUM BRAKE
INSPECTION
BR1542
1.
INSPECT DISASSEMBLED PARTS
Inspect the disassembled parts for wear, rust or damage.
2.
MEASURE BRAKE SHOE LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the shoe lining thickness.
Standard thickness: 5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the thickness is less than the minimum, or shows signs of uneven wear, replace the brake shoes.
HINT:
If any of the brake shoes have to be replaced, replace all of the
rear brake shoes in order to maintain even braking.
BR0AY–03
3.
MEASURE BRAKE DRUM INSIDE DIAMETER
Using brake drum gauge or equivalent, measure the inside diameter of the drum.
Standard inside diameter: 228.6 mm (9.000 in.)
Maximum inside diameter: 230.6 mm (9.079 in.)
If the drum is scored or worn, the brake drum may be lathed to
the maximum inside diameter.
F06408
4.
INSPECT REAR BRAKE LINING AND DRUM FOR
PROPER CONTACT
If the contact between the brake lining and drum is improper, repair the lining with a brake shoe grinder, or replace the brake
shoe assembly.
BR1543
Author:
Date:
2057
BR–35
BRAKE
–
REAR DRUM BRAKE
BR0AZ–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal
(See page BR–32).
NOTICE:
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease and high temperature grease to the parts indicated by the arrows
(See page BR–31).
1.
AFTER INSTALLATION, FILL BRAKE RESERVOIR
WITH BRAKE FLUID, BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM
(See page BR–4)
2.
CHECK FOR LEAKS
3.
CHECK OPERATION OF AUTOMATIC ADJUSTING
MECHANISM
(a) Move the parking brake lever of the rear shoe back and
forth. Check that the adjuster turns.
If the adjuster does not turn, check for incorrect installation of
the rear brake.
(b) Adjust the adjuster length as short as possible.
W01679
(c)
(d)
Align the adjusting hole on the brake drum and the largest
hole on the axle carrier, install the brake drum.
Pull the parking brake lever all the way up until a clicking
sound can no longer be heard.
BR1553
4.
CHECK CLEARANCE BETWEEN BRAKE SHOES AND
DRUM
(a) Remove the drum.
(b) Measure the brake drum inside diameter and diameter
between the brake shoes. Check that the difference between the diameters is the correct shoe clearance.
Shoe clearance: 0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
If incorrect, check the parking brake system.
F06423
Author:
Date:
2058
BR–36
BRAKE
–
REAR BRAKE PAD
REAR BRAKE PAD
BR0B0–03
COMPONENTS
Pad Support Plate
Anti–squeal Shim
Inner Anti–squeal Shim
Inner Pad
Outer Pad
29 (300, 21)
20 (200, 14)
Pad Support Plate
Anti–squeal Shim
Inner Anti–squeal Shim
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
Disc brake grease
F02610
Author:
Date:
2059
BR–37
BRAKE
–
REAR BRAKE PAD
BR0B1–03
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
Remove the wheel and temporarily fasten the disc with the hub
nuts.
2.
INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
Check the pad thickness through the caliper inspection hole
and replace pads if not within specification.
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
R00591
R00514
R10387
3.
LIFT UP CALIPER
(a) Remove the bolt and flexible hose from the bracket.
(b) Remove the installation bolt from the torque plate.
(c) Lift up the caliper and suspend it securely.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose.
4.
REMOVE 2 BRAKE PADS
5.
REMOVE 4 ANTI–SQUEAL SHIMS
6.
REMOVE 4 PAD SUPPORT PLATES
NOTICE:
The support plates can be used again provided that they
have sufficient rebound, no deformation, cracks or wear,
and have had all rust, dirt and foreign particles cleaned off.
7.
CHECK DISC THICKNESS AND RUNOUT
(See page BR–42)
8.
INSTALL 4 PAD SUPPORT PLATES
9.
INSTALL NEW PADS
NOTICE:
When replacing worn pads, the anti–squeal shims must be
replaced together with the pads.
(a) Apply disc brake grease to both side of the inner anti–
squeal shims (See page BR–36).
(b) Install the 2 anti–squeal shims on each pad.
(c) Install 2 pads with the pad wear indicator plate facing upward.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease adhering to the friction
surfaces of the pads or the disc.
10. INSTALL CALIPER
(a) Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the reservoir.
(b) Press in the piston with a hammer handle or similar implement.
HINT:
If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the bleeder plug and
push in the piston while letting some brake fluid escape.
(c) Install the caliper and torque the installation bolt.
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(d) Install the flexible hose and bolt to the bracket.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2060
BR–38
BRAKE
11.
12.
13.
–
REAR BRAKE PAD
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1.050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
DEPRESS BRAKE PEDAL SEVERAL TIMES
CHECK THAT FLUID LEVEL IS AT MAX LINE
Author:
Date:
2061
BR–39
BRAKE
–
REAR BRAKE CALIPER
REAR BRAKE CALIPER
BR0B2–03
COMPONENTS
29 (300, 21)
20 (200, 14)
Gasket
29 (300, 21)
47 (475, 34)
Caliper
Torque Plate
Disc
Plug
Bleeder Plug
8.3 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
Dust Boot
Main Pin Boot
Piston Seal
Piston
Main Pin
Boot
Dust Boot
26 (270, 20)
Set Ring
Sliding Bushing
Anti–squeal Shim
Inner Anti–squeal Shim
Pad Support Plate
Inner Pad
Outer Pad
Inner Anti–squeal Shim
Anti–squeal Shim
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
Disc brake grease
W03262
Author:
Date:
2062
BR–40
BRAKE
–
REAR BRAKE CALIPER
BR0B3–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
W03263
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1.050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE
Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper,
then disconnect the flexible hose from the caliper.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Insert the flexible hose lock securely in the lock hole in the caliper.
(b) Use a container to catch the brake fluid as it drains out.
3.
REMOVE CALIPER
(a) Remove the installation bolt.
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(b) Remove the caliper from the torque plate.
4.
REMOVE 2 BRAKE PADS WITH 4 ANTI–SQUEAL
SHIMS
5.
REMOVE 4 PAD SUPPORT PLATES
NOTICE:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
There should be no oil or grease adhering to the friction
surfaces of the pads or disc.
6.
REMOVE MAIN PIN
Loosen the main pin installation bolt and remove the main pin.
Torque: 26 N·m (270 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
W03264
Author:
Date:
2063
BR–41
BRAKE
–
REAR BRAKE CALIPER
BR0B4–02
DISASSEMBLY
R00520
1.
REMOVE SLIDING BUSHING
2.
REMOVE 2 DUST BOOTS
3.
REMOVE MAIN PIN BOOT
NOTICE:
Ensure that the boots are secured firmly to the bushing and
caliper grooves.
4.
REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT SET RING AND BOOT
(See step 1 on page BR–27)
5.
REMOVE PISTON (See step 2 on page BR–27)
6.
REMOVE PISTON SEAL (See step 3 on page BR–27)
Author:
Date:
2064
BR–42
BRAKE
–
REAR BRAKE CALIPER
BR0B5–02
INSPECTION
1.
W03265
MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
(See step 1 on page BR–28)
Standard thickness: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
2.
MEASURE DISC THICKNESS
(See step 2 on page BR–28)
Standard thickness: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum thickness: 9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
3.
MEASURE DISC RUNOUT
(See step 3 on page BR–28)
Maximum disc runout: 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
If the disc’s runout is maximum value or greater, check the bearing play in the axial direction and check the axle hub runout
(See page SA–52). If the bearing play and axle hub runout are
not abnormal, adjust the disc runout or grind it on a ”On–Car”
brake lathe.
4.
IF NECESSARY, ADJUST DISC RUNOUT
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and torque plate.
(b) Remove the hub nuts and the disc. Reinstall the disc in
the position turned 1/5 from its original position on the
hub. Install and torque the hub nuts.
Remeasure the disc runout. Make a note of the runout
and the disc’s position on the hub.
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
(c) Repeat (b) until the disc has been installed on the 3 remaining hub positions.
(d) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is less than
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.), install the disc in that position.
(e) If the minimum runout recorded in (b) and (c) is greater
than 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.), replace the disc and repeat
step 3.
(f)
Install the torque plate and torque the mounting bolts.
Torque: 47 N·m (475 kgf·cm, 34 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2065
BR–43
BRAKE
–
REAR BRAKE CALIPER
BR0B6–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BR–41).
NOTICE:
Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the parts indicated by the arrows (See page BR–24).
Author:
Date:
2066
BR–44
BRAKE
–
REAR BRAKE CALIPER
BR0B7–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BR–40).
HINT:
After installation, fill the brake reservoir with brake fluid and bleed the brake system
(See page BR–4).
Check for leaks.
Author:
Date:
2067
BR–45
BRAKE
–
PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE
BR0B8–03
COMPONENTS
Guide Plate
Shoe Strut
Adjuster
Shim
Spring
Rear Disc Brake
Assembly
C–washer
Parking Brake
Lever
47 (475, 34)
Pin
Rear Shoe
Shoe Return Spring
Pin
Front Shoe
Disc
Adjuster
Tension Spring
Shoe Hold–down Spring
Plug
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Shoe Hold–down Spring Cup
Non–reusable part
High temperature grease
W03275
Author:
Date:
2068
BR–46
BRAKE
–
PARKING BRAKE
BR0B9–03
DISASSEMBLY
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
W03265
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1.050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
REMOVE REAR DISC BRAKE ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 mounting bolts and remove the disc brake
assembly.
Torque: 47 N·m (475 kgf·cm, 34 ft·lbf)
Suspend the disc brake securely. Ensure that the hose is
not stretched.
3.
REMOVE DISC
Release the parking brake lever and remove the disc.
HINT:
If the disc cannot be removed easily, turn the shoe adjuster until
the wheel turns freely.
R00309
4.
REMOVE SHOE RETURN SPRINGS
Using needle–nose pliers, remove the shoe return springs.
5.
REMOVE FRONT SHOE ADJUSTER AND TENSION
SPRING
(a) Slide out the front shoe and remove the shoe adjuster.
(b) Remove the shoe strut with the spring.
(c) Remove the shoe hold–down spring cups, spring and pin.
(d) Disconnect the tension spring and remove the front shoe.
BR3948
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE REAR SHOE
Slide out the rear shoe.
Remove the tension spring from the rear shoe.
Remove the shoe hold–down spring cups, spring and pin.
Using needle–nose pliers, disconnect the parking brake
cable from the parking brake shoe lever.
R00310
Author:
Date:
2069
BR–47
BRAKE
–
PARKING BRAKE
BR0BA–02
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT DISASSEMBLED PARTS
Inspect the disassembled parts for wear, rust or damage.
2.
MEASURE BRAKE SHOE LINING THICKNESS
(See step 2 on page BR–34)
Standard thickness: 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
3.
MEASURE DISC INSIDE DIAMETER
(See step 3 on page BR–34)
Standard inside diameter: 170 mm (6.69 in.)
Maximum inside diameter: 171 mm (6.73 in.)
4.
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE LINING AND DISC FOR
PROPER CONTACT (See step 4 on page BR–34)
5.
MEASURE CLEARANCE BETWEEN PARKING
BRAKE SHOE AND LEVER
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard clearance: Less than 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
Shim
Clearance
R00343
If the clearance is not within the specification, replace the shim
with one of the correct size.
Shim Thickness
Shim Thickness
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
–
6.
(a)
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE SHIM
Using a screwdriver, remove the C–washer and shim.
(b)
(c)
Install the correct size shim with a new C–washer.
Remeasure the clearance.
R00312
R00313
Author:
Date:
2070
BR–48
BRAKE
–
PARKING BRAKE
BR0BB–02
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly
(See page BR–46).
NOTICE:
Apply high temperature grease to the parts indicated by the
arrows (See page BR–45).
1.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
(a) Temporarily install the hub nuts.
(b) Remove the hole plug.
(c)
Contract
(d)
(e)
2.
(a)
(b)
Expand
BR0823
(c)
3.
Turn the adjuster and expand the shoes until the disc
locks.
Return the adjuster 8 notches.
Install the hole plug.
SETTLING PARKING BRAKE SHOES AND DISC
With the parking brake release button pushed in, pull the
lever with 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) of force.
Drive the vehicle at about 50 km/h (31 mph) on a safe, level and dry road for about 400 meters (0.25 mile) in this
condition.
Repeat this procedure 2 or 3 times.
RECHECK AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE LEVER
TRAVEL (See page BR–8)
Author:
Date:
2071
BR–49
BRAKE
–
PROPORTIONING VALVE (P VALVE)
PROPORTIONING VALVE (P VALVE)
BR0BC–03
INSPECTION
SST
SST
W04698
1.
2.
3.
INSTALL LSPV GAUGE (SST)
SST 09709–29018
BLEED AIR FROM FLUID PRESSURE GAUGE
RAISE MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE AND CHECK REAR WHEEL CYLINDER OR CALIPER
PRESSURE
Master cylinder fluid pressure
Rear brake cylinder fluid pressure
2,452 kPa (25 kgf/cm2, 356 psi)
2,452 kPa (25 kgf/cm2, 356 psi)
7,845 kPa (80 kgf/cm2, 1,138 psi)
4,413 kPa (45 kgf/cm2, 640 psi)
2,942 kPa (30 kgf/cm2, 427 psi)
2,942 kPa (30 kgf/cm2, 427 psi)
7,845 kPa (80 kgf/cm2, 1,138 psi)
5,982 kPa (61 kgf/cm2, 868 psi)
5S–FE engine:
1MZ–FE engine:
If the rear brake cylinder pressure is incorrect, replace the P valve assembly.
4.
REMOVE LSPV GAUGE (SST) AND BLEED BRAKE SYSTEM (See page BR–4)
5.
CHECK FOR LEAKS
Author:
Date:
2072
BR–50
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (DENSO Made)
ABS ACTUATOR (DENSO Made)
BR0BD–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
W03244
HINT:
Using the ABS actuator checker (SST), check the operation of
the actuator. If the actuator does not operate, check the operation of sub–wire harness G according to the instructions on
pages DI–502 and DI–507. If the solenoid and/or pump motor
relay are abnormal, replace the relay and inspect the actuator
operation again.
1.
INSPECT BATTERY POSITIVE VOLTAGE
Battery positive voltage: 10 – 14 V
2.
DISCONNECT CONNECTORS
Disconnect the 2 connectors from the actuator.
3.
CONNECT ACTUATOR CHECKER (SST)
(a) Connect the actuator checker (SST) to the actuator side
wire harness via the sub–wire harness (SST), as shown.
SST 09990–00150, 09990–00250, 09990–00300,
09990–00360
(b)
Connect the red cable of the checker to the battery positive (+) terminal and black cable to the negative (–) terminal. Connect the black cable of the sub–wire harness to
the battery negative (–) terminal or body ground.
Sub–Wire Harness G (SST)
ABS Actuator Checker
(SST)
Sub–Wire Harness L (SST)
ABS
Actuator
Sub–Wire Harness I (SST)
R09422
Author:
Date:
2073
BR–51
BRAKE
(c)
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
ABS ACTUATOR (DENSO Made)
Place the ”SHEET P” (SST) on the actuator checker.
SST SST 09990–00430
INSPECT BRAKE ACTUATOR OPERATION
Start the engine, and run it at idle.
Turn the selector switch of the actuator checker to
”FRONT LH” position.
Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
F07214
(d)
Depress the brake pedal and hold it until step (g) is completed.
(e) Push the MAIN push switch, and check that the brake
pedal does not go down.
NOTICE:
Do not keep the MAIN push switch pushed down for more
than 10 seconds.
(f)
Release the switch, and check that the pedal goes down.
W03269
(g)
(h)
Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds,
and check that the pedal returns.
Release the brake pedal.
W03270
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
Depress the brake pedal and hold it for about 15 seconds.
As you hold the pedal down, push the MOTOR switch for
a few seconds. Check that the brake pedal does not pulsate.
Release the brake pedal.
Turn the selector switch to ”REAR RH” position.
Repeat (c) to (j), checking the actuator operation similarly.
W03268
(n) Similarly, inspect ”REAR LH” and ”FRONT RH” position.
HINT:
When inspecting ”FRONT RH” position, push the FRONT RH
switch instead of the MAIN push switch, and you can inspect in
any selector switch position.
W03271
Author:
Date:
2074
BR–52
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (DENSO Made)
(o)
(p)
5.
W03267
Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
Stop the engine.
DISCONNECT ACTUATOR CHECKER (SST) FROM
ACTUATOR
Remove the ”SHEET P” (SST) and disconnect the actuator
checker (SST) and sub–wire harness (SST) from the actuator.
SST 09990–00150, 09990–00250, 09990–00300,
09990–00360, 09990–00430
6.
CONNECT CONNECTORS
Connect the 2 connectors to the actuator.
7.
CLEAR DTC (See page DI–493)
Author:
Date:
2075
BR–53
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (DENSO Made)
BR0BE–02
COMPONENTS
15 (155, 11)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
ABS Actuator
19 (195, 14)
A/C Tube Clamp
Bracket
Cushion
Holder
Cushion
19 (195, 14)
Actuator Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
W03266
Author:
Date:
2076
BR–54
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (DENSO Made)
BR0BF–02
REMOVAL
SST
W03243
1.
REMOVE RIGHT FRONT FENDER LINER
2.
REMOVE A/C TUBE CLAMP BRACKET BOLT
3.
DISCONNECT BRAKE LINES
Using SST, disconnect the 6 brake lines from the ABS actuator.
SST
09751–36011
Torque: 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
4.
REMOVE ABS ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 blots, 2 nuts and ABS actuator assembly.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
5.
REMOVE ABS ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and ABS actuator from actuator
bracket.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
(b) Remove the 2 holders and 3 cushions from the ABS actuator.
Author:
Date:
2077
BR–55
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (DENSO Made)
BR0BG–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BR–54).
HINT:
After installation, fill the brake reservoir with brake fluid, bleed the brake system (See page BR–4).
Check for leaks.
Author:
Date:
2078
BR–56
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (BOSCH Made)
ABS ACTUATOR (BOSCH Made)
BR0BH–03
COMPONENTS
15 (155, 11)
9.0 (92, 80 in.·lbf)
Holder
ABS Actuator
(w/ ECU)
19 (195, 14)
Cushion
A/C Tube Clamp Bracket
Cushion
19 (195, 14)
Actuator Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
W03327
2.6 (27, 23 in.·lbf)
ECU
Actuator
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F07215
Author:
Date:
2079
BR–57
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (BOSCH Made)
BR0BI–03
REMOVAL
SST
1.
REMOVE RIGHT FRONT FENDER LINER
2.
REMOVE A/C TUBE CLAMP BRACKET BOLT
3.
DISCONNECT BRAKE LINES
Using SST, disconnect the 6 brake lines from the ABS actuator.
SST 09751–36011
Torque: 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
W03324
Release Bar
W03325
4.
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
Pull out the release bar, and disconnect the connector.
5.
REMOVE ABS ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and ABS actuator assembly.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
6.
REMOVE ABS ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and ABS actuator.
Torque: 9.0 N·m (92 kgf·cm, 80 in.·lbf)
(b) Remove the 2 holders and 3 cushions from the ABS actuator.
Author:
Date:
2080
BR–58
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (BOSCH Made)
BR0BJ–02
DISASSEMBLY
W03326
1.
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR
Disconnect the connector, and remove the wire harness from
the harness guide.
2.
REMOVE ECU
(a) Using a T20 torx wrench, loosen the 6 screws.
Torque: 2.6 N·m (27 kgf·cm, 23 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
When removing the ECU from the actuator, it must be
removed it upward.
At the time of reassembly, tighten the screws according to the order shown on the left.
(b) Remove the ECU from the actuator.
NOTICE:
Protect the actuator in order to prevent sealing surface
from getting dirty and causing damage on the valve body.
If the dirt and the like are stuck to the sealing surface, use
plastic tools or soft objects to remove the dirt. Do not use
chemical solvents.
Author:
Date:
2081
BR–59
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (BOSCH Made)
BR0BK–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BR–58).
Author:
Date:
2082
BR–60
BRAKE
–
ABS ACTUATOR (BOSCH Made)
BR0BL–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BR–57).
HINT:
After installation, fill the brake reservoir with brake fluid, bleed the brake system (See page BR–4).
Check for leaks.
Author:
Date:
2083
BR–61
BRAKE
–
ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR
ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR
BR07A–06
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
HINT:
Using the ABS actuator checker (SST), check the operation of
the actuator. If the actuator does not operate, check the operation of sub–wire harness G according to the instructions on
pages DI–584 and DI–587. If the solenoid and/or pump motor
relay are abnormal, replace the relay and inspect the actuator
operation again.
1.
W03246
INSPECT BATTERY POSITIVE VOLTAGE
Battery positive voltage: 10 – 14 V
2.
DISCONNECT CONNECTORS
Disconnect the 2 connectors from the actuator.
3.
CONNECT ABS ACTUATOR CHECKER (SST)
(a) Connect the actuator checker (SST) to the actuator side
wire harness via the sub–wire harness (SST), as shown.
SST 09990–00150, 09990–00250, 09990–00360,
09990–00450
(b)
Connect the red cable of the checker to the battery positive (+) terminal and black cable to the negative (–) terminal. Connect the black cable of the sub–wire harness to
the battery negative (–) terminal or body ground.
Sub – Wire Harness G (SST)
Sub – Wire
harness L
(SST)
ABS Actuator Checker
(SST)
FF TRC
Connector
FR TRC
Connector
White
Connector
Sub – Wire harness P (SST)
ABS & TRAC
Actuator
*: Connect the white connector with
the labeled (FF TRC) connector.
W03897
Author:
Date:
2084
BR–62
BRAKE
(c)
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR
Place the ”SHEET A” (SST) on the actuator checker.
SST 09990–00163
INSPECT BRAKE ACTUATOR OPERATION
Start the engine, and run it at idle.
Turn the selector switch of the actuator checker to
”FRONT RH” position.
Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
BR1811
(d)
Depress the brake pedal and hold it until step (g) is completed.
(e) Push the POWER SWITCH, and check that the brake
pedal does not go down.
NOTICE:
Do not keep the POWER SWITCH pushed down for more
than 10 seconds.
(f)
Release the switch, and check that the pedal goes down.
R00324
(g)
(h)
Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds,
and check that the pedal returns.
Release the brake pedal.
R00325
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
Depress the brake pedal and hold it for about 15 seconds.
As you hold the pedal down, push the MOTOR switch for
a few seconds. Check that the brake pedal does not pulsate.
Release the brake pedal.
Turn the selector switch to ”FRONT LH” position.
Repeat (c) to (j), checking the actuator operation similarly.
R00326
(n) Similarly, inspect ”REAR RH” and ”REAR LH” position.
HINT:
When inspecting ”REAR LH” position, push the REAR LH
switch instead of the POWER SWITCH, and you can inspect in
any selector switch position.
BR1813
Author:
Date:
2085
BR–63
BRAKE
–
ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR
(o)
(p)
5.
BR1811
Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
Stop the engine.
DISCONNECT ACTUATOR CHECKER (SST) FROM
ACTUATOR
Remove the ”SHEET A” (SST) and disconnect the actuator
checker (SST) and sub–wire harness (SST) from the actuator.
SST 09990–00150, 09990–00163, 09990–00250,
09990–00360, 09990–00450
6.
CONNECT CONNECTORS
Connect the 2 connectors to the actuator.
7.
CLEAR DTC (See page DI–574)
Author:
Date:
2086
BR–64
BRAKE
–
ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR
BR077–04
COMPONENTS
15 (155, 11)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
20 (200, 14)
ABS & TRAC
Actuator
19 (195, 14)
A/C Tube Clamp
Bracket
Cushion
Holder
Cushion
19 (195, 14)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
Actuator Bracket
: Specified torque
W03272
Author:
Date:
2087
BR–65
BRAKE
–
ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR
BR078–03
REMOVAL
SST
W03245
1.
REMOVE RIGHT FRONT FENDER LINER
2.
REMOVE A/C TUBE CLAMP BRACKET BOLT
3.
DISCONNECT BRAKE LINES
Using SST, disconnect the 6 brake lines from the ABS & TRAC
actuator.
SST 09751–36011
Torque:
10 mm nut 15 N·m (155 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
12 mm nut 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
4.
REMOVE ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 blots, 2 nuts and ABS & TRAC actuator assembly.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
5.
REMOVE ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and ABS & TRAC actuator from actuator bracket.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
(b) Remove the 2 holders and 3 cushions from the ABS &
TRAC actuator.
Author:
Date:
2088
BR–66
BRAKE
–
ABS & TRAC ACTUATOR
BR079–03
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BR–65).
HINT:
After installation, fill the brake reservoir with brake fluid and bleed the brake system.
(See page BR–4)
Check for leaks.
Author:
Date:
2089
BR–67
BRAKE
–
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BR0BQ–03
COMPONENTS
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
29 (300, 21)
Front Speed Sensor
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
7.8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
W03273
Author:
Date:
2090
BR–68
BRAKE
–
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BR0BR–03
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Remove the fender liner.
Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
2.
(a)
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR
Remove the bolt, flexible hose and speed sensor harness
clamp from the shock absorber.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 21 ft·lbf)
Remove the resin clip and clamp bolt holding the sensor
harness to the body.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
Remove the speed sensor from the steering knuckle.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
R00327
(b)
(c)
W04507
Author:
Date:
2091
BR–69
BRAKE
–
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BR0BS–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See pageBR–68).
HINT:
After installation, check the speed sensor signal (See page DI–493, DI–539).
Author:
Date:
2092
BR–70
BRAKE
–
REAR SPEED SENSOR
REAR SPEED SENSOR
BR0BT–03
COMPONENTS
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
7.8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
Rear Speed Sensor
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
W03274
Author:
Date:
2093
BR–71
BRAKE
–
REAR SPEED SENSOR
BR0BU–03
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Remove the seat cushion and side seatback
(See page BO–114 or BO–119).
Disconnect the speed sensor connector, and pull out the
sensor wire harness with the grommet.
R00330
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SPEED SENSOR
Remove the 2 clamp bolts holding the sensor wire harness to the body and shock absorber.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
Remove the speed sensor from the axle carrier.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
W04508
Author:
Date:
2094
BR–72
BRAKE
–
REAR SPEED SENSOR
BR0BV–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BR–71).
HINT:
After installation, check the speed sensor signal (See page DI–493, DI–539).
Author:
Date:
2095
SA–1
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
SA077–01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Wander/pulls
3. Steering linkage (Loosen or worn)
4. Hub bearings (Worn)
5. Suspension parts (Worn)
6. Steering gear (Out of adjustment or broken)
1. Vehicle (Overloaded)
2. Spring (Weak)
–
SA–33
SA–56
SA–33
SA–56
Bottoming
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Stabilizer bar (Bent or broken)
SA–2
SA–47
SA–69
SA–33
SA–56
Sways/pitches
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheels (Out of balance)
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
Front wheel shimmy
4. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
5. Ball joints (Worn)
6. Hub bearings (Worn)
7. Steering linkage (Loosen or worn)
8. Steering gear (Out of adjustment or broken)
Abnormal tire wear
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheels (Out of balance)
3. Suspension parts (Worn)
4. Shock absorber (Worn)
Author:
SA–2
SA–4
SA–7
–
SA–10
–
–
SA–2
SA–2
SA–33
SA–56
SA–4
SA–7
SA–43
SA–10
–
–
SA–2
SA–2
–
SA–33
SA–56
Date:
1952
SA–2
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
TIRE AND WHEEL
TIRE AND WHEEL
SA078–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT TIRE
Check the tires for wear and proper inflation pressure.
Cold inflation pressure:
Normal driving
Tire size
R03031
Front, Rear
kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi)
P195/70R14 90S, 90H
210 (2.1, 30)
P205/65R15 92H
*1 220 (2.2, 32)
*2 200 (2.0, 29)
*1: For all loads including full rated loads
*2: For reduced loads (1 to 4 passengers)
Trailer towing
Tire size
Front, Rear
kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi)
P195/70R14 90S
*1 210 (2.1, 30)
*2 240 (2.4, 36)
P205/65R15 92H
*1 220 (2.2, 32)
*2 240 (2.4, 36)
*1: For driving under 160 km/h (100 mph)
*2: For driving at 160 km/h (100 mph) or over
(b) Check the tire runout.
Tire runout: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.) or less
2.
ROTATING TIRES
HINT:
See the illustration for where to rotate each tire.
Front
R15157
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT WHEEL BALANCE
Check and adjust the Off–the–car balance.
If necessary, check and adjust the On–the–car balance.
Imbalance after adjustment:
8.0 g (0.018 lb) or less
R07928
Author:
Date:
1953
SA–3
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
4.
(a)
(b)
W03084
5.
6.
7.
8.
–
TIRE AND WHEEL
CHECK WHEEL BEARING LOOSENESS
Check the backlash in the bearing shaft direction.
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Check the axle hub deviation.
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
CHECK FRONT SUSPENSION FOR LOOSENESS
CHECK STEERING LINKAGE FOR LOOSENESS
CHECK BALL JOINT FOR LOOSENESS
CHECK SHOCK ABSORBER WORKS PROPERLY
Check for oil leaks
Check mounting bushings for wear
Check front and rear of the vehicle for bounce
Author:
Date:
1954
SA–4
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Front
SA079–01
INSPECTION
1.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
Tire size
Front*1 mm (in.)
Rear*2
195/70R14
212 (8.35)
264 (10.39)
205/65R15
215 (8.46)
266 (10.49)
mm (in.)
*1:
W03085
Rear
Front measuring point
Measure from the ground to the center of the front side lower
suspension arm mounting bolt.
*2: Rear measuring point
Measure from the ground to the center of the strut rod mounting
bolt.
NOTICE:
Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust the vehicle
height to the specification.
If the vehicle height is not within the specification, try to adjust
it by pushing down on or lifting the body.
R03030
2.
INSTALL CAMBER–CASTER–KINGPIN GAUGE
ONTO VEHICLE OR POSITION VEHICLE ON WHEEL
ALIGNMENT TESTER
Follow the specific instructions of the equipment manufacturer.
3.
INSPECT CAMBER, CASTER AND STEERING AXIS
INCLINATION
5S–FE
1MZ–FE
Left–right error
–0°36’ ± 45’
(–0.6° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
–0°37’ ± 45’
(–0.62° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Left–right error
2°10’ ± 45’
(2.17° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
2°11’ ± 45’
(2.18° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
13°01’ ± 45’
(13.02° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
13°04’ ± 45’
(13.07° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Camber
Z03382
Caster
Steering axis inclination
Left–right error
HINT:
If the caster and steering axis inclination are not within the specification, after the camber has correctly adjusted, recheck the
suspension parts for damaged and/or worn out parts.
A
4.
B
D
INSPECT TOE–IN
Toe–in
(Total)
Front
A + B: 0° ± 12’ (0° ± 0.2°)
C – D: 0 ± 2 mm (0 ± 0.08 in.)
If the toe–in is not within the specification, adjust it at the rack
ends.
C
SA3213
Author:
Date:
1955
SA–5
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
5.
ADJUST CAMBER
NOTICE:
After the camber has been adjusted, inspect the toe–in.
(a) Remove the front wheels and speed sensor clamp.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts on the lower side of the shock absorber.
(c) Coat the threads of the nuts with engine oil.
(d) Temporarily install the 2 nuts.
W03086
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
HINT:
Adjust the camber by pushing or pulling the lower side of
the shock absorber in the direction in which the camber
adjustment is required.
Tighten the nuts.
Torque: 211 N·m (2,150 kgf·cm, 156 ft·lbf)
Install the front wheels.
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
Check the camber.
Try to adjust the camber to the center value.
Adjusting value for the set bolts is 6’ – 30’ (0.1° – 0.5°).
If the camber is not within the specification, using the table below, estimate for how much additional camber adjustment will
be required, and select the camber adjusting bolt.
1
2
Adjusting Bolt
Set Bolt
Bolt
90105–15001 90105–15004 90105–15005
1 Dot
F02267
Adjusting
Value
1
2
1
2
90105–15006
2 Dots
3 Dots
1
1
2
2
15’
30’
45’
1°00’
1°15’
1°30’
F01195
(i)
Follow the above mentioned steps again. Between step
(b) and (c), exchange 1 or 2 selected bolts.
HINT:
When exchanging the 2 bolts, exchange 1 bolt for each time.
Author:
Date:
1956
SA–6
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
ADJUST TOE–IN
Remove the boot clamps.
Loosen the tie rod end lock nuts.
Turn the left and right rack ends an equal amount to adjust
the toe–in.
HINT:
W03088
(d)
Try to adjust the toe–in to the center value.
Make sure that the length of the left and right rack ends
is the same.
Rack end length difference:
1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
Torque the tie rod end lock nuts.
Torque: 74 N·m (750 kgf·cm, 54 ft·lbf)
Place the boot on the seat and install the clip it.
(e)
HINT:
Make sure that the boots are not twisted.
A
B
B
7.
INSPECT WHEEL ANGLE
Turn the steering wheel fully, and measure the turning angle.
A
Front
A: Inside
B: Outside
SA0028
Tire size
Inside wheel
Outside wheel
195/70R14
37°12’ ± 2°
(37.2° ± 2°)
32°21’
(32.45°)
205/65R15
35°47’ ± 2°
(35.78° ± 2°)
31°25’
(31.42°)
If the wheel angles differ from the specification, check the left
and right rack end length.
Author:
Date:
1957
SA–7
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SA07A–01
INSPECTION
1.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
Vehicle height: See page SA–4
NOTICE:
Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust the vehicle
height to specification.
2.
INSTALL CAMBER – CASTER – KINGPIN GAUGE
ONTO VEHICLE OR POSITION VEHICLE ON WHEEL
ALIGNMENT TESTER
Follow the specific instructions on the equipment manufacturer.
3.
INSPECT CAMBER
Camber
Left–right error
5S–FE
1MZ–FE
–0°42’ ± 45’
(–0.7° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
–0°45’ ± 45’
(–0.75° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
HINT:
Camber in not adjustable, it measurement is not within the
specifications, inspect the suspension parts for damaged and/
or worn–out parts and replace them as necessary.
A
D
4.
B
INSPECT TOE–IN
Toe–in
(Total)
Front
A + B: 0°24’ ± 12’ (0.4° ± 0.2°)
C – D: 4 ± 2 mm (0.16 ± 0.08 in.)
If the toe–in is not within the specification, adjust it at the No.2
lower suspension arm.
C
SA3213
5.
(a)
ADJUST TOE–IN
Measure the length of the left and right No.2 lower suspension arms.
No.2 lower suspension arm length difference:
1 mm (0.04 in.) or less
If the left–right difference is larger than the specification, adjust
the length.
W03090
Author:
Date:
1958
SA–8
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
(b)
(c)
–
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Loosen the lock nuts.
Turn the left and right lower suspension arms an equal
amount to adjust toe–in.
HINT:
(d)
W03091
Try to adjust the toe–in to the center value.
One turn of the each adjusting tube will adjust the toe–in
about 36’ (0.6°, 6.7 mm, 0.264 in.).
Torque the lock nuts.
Torque: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1959
SA–9
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE HUB
FRONT AXLE HUB
SA07B–01
COMPONENTS
Front Shock Absorber
211 (2,150, 156)
Tie Rod End
Front Drive Shaft
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
Brake Caliper
107 (1,090,79)
ABS Speed Sensor
Hub Bolt
49 (500, 36)
Cotter pin
Cotter pin
Lock Cap
Disc
Lower Suspension Arm
294 (3,000, 217)
Snap Ring
127 (1,300, 94)
Cotter pin
Steering Knuckle
Dust Deflector
Dust Cover
Bearing
123 (1,250, 90)
Axle Hub
Lower Ball Joint
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
8.3 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
W03092
Author:
Date:
1960
SA–10
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE HUB
SA07C–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
CHECK BEARING BACKLASH AND AXLE HUB DEVIATION
Remove the 2 bolts, brake caliper and disc.
Support the brake caliper securely.
(c)
W03084
W03093
Using a dial indicator near the center of the axle hub and
check the backlash in the bearing shaft direction.
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace the bearing.
(d) Using a dial indicator, check the deviation at the surface
of the axle hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the deviation exceeds the maximum, replace the bearing.
(e) Install the disc, 2 bolts and brake caliper.
Torque: 107 N·m (1,090 kgf·cm, 79 ft·lbf)
3.
REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT LOCK NUT
(a) Remove the cotter pin and lock cap.
(b) With applying the brakes, remove the nut.
Torque: 294 N·m (3,000 kgf·cm, 217 ft·lbf)
(c) Remove the brake caliper and disc.
4.
w/ ABS:
REMOVE ABS SPEED SENSOR AND WIRE HARNESS
CLAMP
Torque: 8.0 N·m (82 kgf·cm, 71 in.·lbf)
5.
LOOSEN 2 NUTS ON LOWER SIDE OF SHOCK ABSORBER
Torque: 211 N·m (2,150 kgf·cm, 156 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Do not remove the bolts.
At the time of installation, coat the nut’s thread with engine oil.
6.
DISCONNECT TIE ROD END FROM STEERING
KNUCKLE
Remove the cotter pin and nut.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steering
knuckle.
SST 09610–20012
W03139
(a)
(b)
SST
W03094
Author:
Date:
1961
SA–11
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE HUB
7.
W03095
DISCONNECT LOWER BALL JOINT FROM LOWER
ARM
Remove the 2 nuts and bolt.
Torque: 127 N·m (1,300 kgf·cm, 94 ft·lbf)
8.
REMOVE STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
(a) Remove the 2 bolts on the lower side of the shock absorber.
(b) Remove the steering knuckle with the axle hub.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil seal with drive shaft.
Author:
Date:
1962
SA–12
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE HUB
SA07D–01
DISASSEMBLY
SST
1.
REMOVE DUST DEFLECTOR
Using a screwdriver, remove the dust deflector.
2.
REMOVE LOWER BALL JOINT
(a) Remove the cotter pin and nut.
(b) Using SST, remove the lower ball joint.
SST 09628–62011
R08859
3.
(a)
SST
REMOVE AXLE HUB
Using SST, remove the axle hub.
SST 09520–00031
R00789
(b)
Using SST and a press, remove the inner race (outside)
from the axle hub.
SST 09950–00020, 09950–60010 (09951–00400),
09950–70010 (09951–07100)
4.
REMOVE DUST COVER
Using a torx wrench (T30), remove the 4 bolts and dust cover.
SST
W02110
SST
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE BEARING FROM STEERING KNUCKLE
Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Place the inner race on the outside of the bearing.
Using SST and a press, remove the bearing.
SST 09310–35010, 09527–17011
SST
R11486
Author:
Date:
1963
SA–13
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE HUB
SA07E–01
REASSEMBLY
SST
1.
(a)
R00792
INSTALL BEARING
Using SST and a press, install a new bearing to the steering knuckle.
SST 09608–32010
(b) Using snap ring pliers, install a new snap ring.
2.
INSTALL DUST COVER
Place the dust cover and using a torx wrench (T30), torque the
4 bolts.
Torque: 8.3 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
3.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB
Using SST and a press, install the axle hub.
SST 09310–35010, 09608–32010
4.
INSTALL LOWER BALL JOINT
(a) Install the lower ball joint and torque the nut.
Torque: 123 N·m (1,250 kgf·cm, 90 ft·lbf)
(b) Install a new cotter pin.
SST
SST
R08860
5.
INSTALL DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a hammer, install a new dust deflector.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011, 09316–00041),
09608–32010
HINT:
Align the holes for the ABS speed sensor in the dust deflector
and steering knuckle.
SST
SST
Z19236
Author:
Date:
1964
SA–14
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE HUB
SA07F–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–10).
AFTER INSTALLATION, CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page DI–493 or DI–539) AND
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SA–4)
Author:
Date:
1965
SA–15
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT WHEEL HUB BOLT
FRONT WHEEL HUB BOLT
SA07G–01
REPLACEMENT
SST
W03096
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE BRAKE CALIPER AND DISC
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, brake caliper and disc.
(b) Support the brake caliper securely.
3.
REMOVE HUB BOLT
Using SST, remove the hub bolt.
SST 09628–10011
4.
INSTALL HUB BOLT
Install a washer and nut to the hub bolt as shown in the illustration, and install the hub bolt by torquing the nut.
5.
INSTALL BRAKE DISC AND CALIPER
Install the disc, 2 bolts and brake caliper.
6.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
W03097
Author:
Date:
1966
SA–16
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
SA08P–01
COMPONENTS
Fender Apron Seal
Drive Shaft(RH)
Lock Bolt
32 (330, 24)
Fender Apron Seal
Snap Ring
Drive Shaft(LH)
Tie Rod End
Snap Ring
Boot Clamp
Lower
Suspension
Arm
49 (500, 36)
No.2 Dust
Deflector
Cotter pin
Outbord Joint Shaft
127 (1,300, 94)
Snap Ring
Boot
Lock Cap
294 (3,000, 217)
Boot
LH
Inboard Joint
Shaft
Tripod
Inboard Joint Shaft
Dust Cover
Snap Ring
Dust Cover
Center Bearing
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F03274
Author:
Date:
1967
SA–17
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
SA08Q–01
REMOVAL
SST
FA1535
NOTICE:
The hub bearing could be damaged if it is subjected to the
vehicle weight, such as when moving the vehicle with the
drive shaft removed.
Therefore, if it is absolutely necessary to place the vehicle
weight on the hub bearing, first support it with SST.
SST 09608–16042 (09608–02021, 09608–02041)
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL AND FRONT FENDER
APRON SEAL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
4.
5.
W03093
REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT LOCK NUT
Remove the cotter pin and lock cap.
With applying the brakes, remove the nut.
Torque: 294 N·m (3,000 kgf·cm, 217 ft·lbf)
DRAIN GEAR OIL (M/T) or ATF (A/T)
DISCONNECT TIE ROD END FROM STEERING
KNUCKLE (See page SA–10)
DISCONNECT LOWER BALL JOINT FROM LOWER
SUSPENSION ARM (See page SA–10)
6.
(a)
DISCONNECT DRIVE SHAFT FROM AXLE HUB
Using a plastic hammer, disconnect the drive shaft from
the axle hub.
NOTICE:
Cover the drive shaft boot with cloth to protect it from damage.
(b) Push the front axle hub toward the outside of the vehicle,
and separate the drive shaft from the axle hub.
W03142
Author:
Date:
1968
SA–18
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
LH
W03143
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
7.
REMOVE LH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Using a brass bar and hammer, remove the drive shaft.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Coat gear oil to the inboard joint shaft and differential case sliding surface.
Before installing the drive shaft, set the snap ring
with its opening side facing downward.
Whether or not the inboard joint shaft is making contact with the pinion shaft can be known by the sound
or feeling when driving it in.
After installation, check that there is 2 – 3 mm (0.08
– 0.12 in.) of play in the axial direction.
After installation, check that the drive shaft cannot
be removed by hand.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring from the inboard joint shaft.
8.
(a)
RH
–
REMOVE RH DRIVE SHAFT
Remove the bearing lock bolt.
Torque: 32 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Using pliers, remove the snap ring and drive shaft.
(b)
HINT:
At the time of installation, coat gear oil to the inboard joint shaft
and differential case sliding surface.
W03144
Author:
Date:
1969
SA–19
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
SA08R–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N00191
(d)
2.
(a)
(b)
CHECK DRIVE SHAFT
Check to see that there is no play in the outboard joint
shaft.
Check to see that the inboard joint shaft slides smoothly
in the thrust direction.
Check to see that there is no remarkable play in the radial
direction of the inboard joint shaft.
Check for damage to boots.
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMPS
Using pliers, draw the hooks together and remove the
large inboard joint boot clamp.
Using a side cutter, cut the small inboard and 2 outboard
joint boot clamps and remove them.
3.
(a)
Matchmarks
FA1615
REMOVE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
Place matchmarks on the tripod, inboard and outboardjoint shafts.
NOTICE:
Do not punch the marks.
(b) Remove the inboard joint shaft from the outboard joint
shaft.
4.
REMOVE TRIPOD
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
(b) Using a snap ring expander, temporarily slide the snap
ring toward the outboard joint shaft side.
(c)
(d)
Matchmarks
Place matchmarks on the outboard joint shaft and tripod.
Using a brass bar and hammer, remove the tripod from
the outboard joint shaft.
(e) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
5.
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOTS
Slide out the 2 boots.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the outboard joint.
SA1443
Author:
Date:
1970
SA–20
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
6.
SST
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
REMOVE DUST COVER
(LH drive shaft)
Using SST and a press, remove the dust cover from the
inboard joint shaft.
SST 09950–00020
R09716
(RH drive shaft)
Using a press, remove the dust cover from the inboard
joint shaft.
SA1446
7.
SST
(a)
(b)
RH DRIVE SHAFT:
DISASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
Using SST and a press, remove the dust cover.
SST 09950–00020
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
R09717
(c)
(d)
8.
(a)
(b)
Using a press, remove the bearing.
Remove the snap ring.
REMOVE NO.2 DUST DEFLECTOR
Mount outboard joint shaft in a soft jaw vise.
Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the No.2 dust
deflector.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the ABS speed sensor rotor.
SA1451
Author:
Date:
1971
SA–21
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
SA08S–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL NO.2 DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a press, install a new No.2 dust deflector.
SST 09309–36010, 09316–20011
SST
R15532
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
RH DRIVE SHAFT:
ASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
Install a new snap ring to the inboard joint shaft.
Using a press, install a new bearing.
Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
FA1888
(d)
1.0 mm
(0.039 in.)
Using SST, an extension bar and press, install a new dust
cover.
SST 09506–35010
HINT:
The clearance between the dust cover and the bearing should
be kept in the range shown in the illustration.
SST
→
→
FA1971
3.
INSTALL DUST COVER
(LH drive shaft)
Using a press, install a new dust cover.
SA1459
(RH drive shaft)
Using a press, install a new dust cover until the distance
from the tip of the inboard joint shaft to the dust cover falls
within the specification, as shown in the illustration.
86 – 87mm
(3.39 – 3.43 in.)
FA1889
Author:
Date:
1972
SA–22
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
Inboard Joint Boot
Outboard Joint Boot
4.
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
TEMPORARILY INSTALL OUTBOARD AND INBOARD
JOINT BOOTS AND NEW BOOT CLAMPS
HINT:
Vinyl tape
F01747
Before installing the boots, wrap the spline of the drive
shaft in vinyl tape to prevent the boots from being damaged.
Before installing the boots, place 3 new clamps to the
small boot ends and large end (wheel side) and then
install boots to drive shaft.
5.
INSTALL TRIPOD
(a) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
(b) Place the beveled side of the tripod axial spline toward the
outboard joint shaft.
(c) Align the matchmarks placed before removal.
(d) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap in the tripod to the outboard joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
(e) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
6.
INSTALL BOOT TO OUTBOARD JOINT SHAFT
Before assembling the boot, coat the outboard joint and boot
with grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity: (Color = Black)
100 – 120 g (3.5 – 4.2 oz.)
7.
INSTALL INBOARD JOINT SHAFT TO OUTBOARD
JOINT SHAFT
(a) Coat the inboard joint and boot with grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity: (Color = Yellow ocher)
125 – 155 g (4.4 – 5.5 oz)
(b) Align the matchmarks placed before removal, and install
the inboard joint shaft to the outboard joint shaft.
(c) Install the boot to the inboard joint shaft.
8.
(a)
(b)
ASSEMBLE BOOT CLAMPS TO BOTH BOOTS
Make sure that the 2 boots are on the shaft groove.
Make sure that the 2 boots are not stretched or contracted
when the drive shaft is at standard length.
Drive shaft standard length
LH
609.2 ± 2.0 mm (23.984 ± 0.079 in.)
RH
867.3 ± 2.0 mm (34.146 ± 0.079 in.)
R00764
Author:
Date:
1973
SA–23
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
(c)
(d)
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
Holding the clamp near the closing hooks, using pliers,
position the holes in the clamp’s free end over the closing
hooks.
Secure clamp by drawing the closing hooks together.
F00615
(e)
(f)
Secure the preplaced 3 clamps onto the boots.
Place SST onto the clamp.
SST 09521–24010
(g) Tighten the SST so that the clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
SST
R10353
(h)
Clearance
9.
Using SST, adjust the clearance of the clamp.
SST 09240–00020
Clearance:
A : 1.9 mm (0.075 in.) or less
B : 1.5 – 2.5 mm (0.059 – 0.098 in.)
C : 3.0 – 4.0 mm (0.118 – 0.157 in.)
CHECK DRIVE SHAFT (See page SA–19)
SST
A
B
C
F00616
Author:
Date:
1974
SA–24
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (5S–FE)
SA08T–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–17).
AFTER INSTALLATION, CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page DI–493 or DI–539) AND
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT(See page SA–4)
Author:
Date:
1975
SA–25
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
SA07H–01
COMPONENTS
Fender Apron Seal
Drive Shaft(RH)
Snap Ring
Fender Apron Seal
Lock Bolt
32 (330, 24)
Snap Ring
Drive Shaft(LH)
Tie Rod End
Outbord Joint Shaft
49 (500, 36)
Lower Suspension Arm
Boot Clamp
Cotter pin
No.2 Dust
Deflector
Lock Cap
127 (1,300, 94)
294 (3,000, 217)
Boot
Snap Ring
Inboard Joint Shaft
LH
Inboard Joint
Shaft
Dust Cover
Center Bearing
Dust Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
W03141
Author:
Date:
1976
SA–26
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
SA07I–01
REMOVAL
(See page SA–17)
Author:
Date:
1977
SA–27
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
SA07J–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
R14967
(d)
2.
(a)
(b)
CHECK DRIVE SHAFT
Check to see that there is no play in the outboard joint
shaft.
Check to see that the inboard joint shaft slides smoothly
in the thrust direction.
Check to see that there is no remarkable play in the radial
direction of the inboard joint shaft.
Check for damage to boots.
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMPS
Using pliers, draw the hooks together and remove the
large inboard joint boot clamp.
Using a side cutter, cut the small inboard and 2 outboard
joint boot clamps and remove them.
3.
matchmarks
W03190
REMOVE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT FROM OUTBOARD
JOINT SHAFT
(a) Place matchmarks on the inboard and outboard joint
shafts.
NOTICE:
Do not punch the marks.
(b) Using a snap ring expander, pull out the outboard joint
shaft expanding the snap ring.
4.
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOTS
Slide out the 2 boots.
5.
REMOVE DUST COVER
(LH drive shaft)
Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the dust cover from
the inboard joint shaft.
(RH drive shaft)
Using a press, remove the dust cover from the inboard joint
shaft.
SA0689
6.
(a)
SST
(b)
RH DRIVE SHAFT:
DISASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
Using SST and a press, remove the dust cover.
SST 09950–00020
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
R09717
Author:
Date:
1978
SA–28
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
(c)
(d)
7.
(a)
(b)
Using a press, remove the bearing.
Remove the snap ring.
REMOVE NO.2 DUST DEFLECTOR
Mount outboard joint shaft in a soft jaw vise.
Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the No.2 dust
deflector.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the ABS speed sensor rotor.
SA1451
Author:
Date:
1979
SA–29
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
SA07K–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL NO.2 DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a press, install a new No.2 dust deflector.
SST 09309–36010, 09316–20011
SST
W02121
2.
SST
(a)
(b)
(c)
RH DRIVE SHAFT:
ASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
Install a new snap ring to the inboard joint shaft.
Using SST and a press, install a new bearing.
SST 09223–56010
Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
W03193
(d)
SST
Using SST and a press, install a new dust cover.
SST 09223–56010
W03316
3.
INSTALL DUST COVER
(LH drive shaft)
Using SST and a press, install a dust cover.
SST 09223–56010, 09555–55010
SST
SST
W03145
(RH drive shaft)
Using SST and a press, install a new dust cover until the distance from the tip of the inboard joint shaft to the dust cover falls
within the specification, as shown in the illustration.
SST 09223–56010
SST
100.5 mm
(3.957 in.)
W03194
Author:
Date:
1980
SA–30
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
Inboard Joint Boot
Outboard Joint Boot
4.
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
TEMPORARILY INSTALL OUTBOARD AND INBOARD
JOINT BOOTS AND NEW BOOT CLAMPS
HINT:
Vinyl Tape
W03195
Before installing the boots, wrap the spline of the drive
shaft in vinyl tape to prevent the boots from being damaged.
Before installing the boots, place 3 new clamps to the
small boot ends and large end (wheel side) and then
install boots to drive shaft.
5.
INSTALL INBOARD JOINT SHAFT TO OUTBOARD
JOINT SHAFT
Align the matchmarks placed at removal, and using a snap ring
expander, put in the inboard joint shaft expanding the snap ring.
6.
INSTALL BOOT TO OUTBOARD JOINT
Before assembling the boot, pack the outboard joint and boot
with grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity: (Color = Black)
105 – 125 g (3.7 – 4.4 oz.)
7.
INSTALL BOOT TO INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
(a) Pack the inboard joint and boot with grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity: (Color = Gray)
Joint side: 142.5 – 157.5 g (5.0 – 5.6 oz.)
Boot side: 52.5 – 57.5 g (2.1 – 2.3 oz.)
(b) Install the boot to the inboard joint shaft.
8.
(a)
(b)
W03196
(c)
(d)
ASSEMBLE BOOT CLAMPS TO BOTH BOOTS
Make sure that the 2 boots are on the shaft groove.
Make sure that the 2 boots are not stretched or contracted
when the drive shaft is at standard length.
Drive shaft standard length:
M/T LH
601.5 ± 2.0 mm (23.681 ± 0.079 in.)
RH
871.6 ± 2.0 mm (34.315 ± 0.079 in.)
A/T LH
586.0 ± 2.0 mm (23.071 ± 0.079 in.)
RH
881.6 ± 2.0 mm (34.709 ± 0.079 in.)
Holding the clamp near the closing hooks, using pliers,
position the holes in the clamp’s free end over the closing
hooks.
Secure clamp by drawing the closing hooks together.
R14973
Author:
Date:
1981
SA–31
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
(e)
(f)
Secure the preplaced 3 clamps onto the boots.
Place SST onto the clamp.
SST 09521–24010
(g) Tighten the SST so that the clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
SST
R10353
(h)
Clearance
9.
Using SST, adjust the clearance of the clamp.
SST 09240–00020
Clearance:
A : 1.9 mm (0.075 in.) or less
B : 1.5 – 2.5 mm (0.059 – 0.098 in.)
C : 3.0 – 4.0 mm (0.118 – 0.157 in.)
CHECK DRIVE SHAFT (See page SA–27)
SST
A
B
C
F02023
Author:
Date:
1982
SA–32
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (1MZ–FE)
SA07L–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–26).
AFTER INSTALLATION, CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page DI–493 or DI–539) AND
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SA–4)
Author:
Date:
1983
SA–33
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SA07M–05
COMPONENTS
80 (820, 59)
49 (500, 36)
Suspension
Support No. 2
Suspension Support
Bearing
Spring Bumper
Spring
Upper Seat
Lower
Insulator
Upper
Insulator
Stabilizer Bar
Link
39 (400, 29)
Shock Absorber
with Coil Spring
Coil Spring
211 (2,150, 156)
Shock
Absorber
Front Drive Shaft
ABS Speed Sensor
Wire Harness Clamp
Dust
Deflector
Tie Rod End
29 (300, 22)
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
Cotter Pin
107 (1,090, 79)
ABS Speed Sensor
123 (1,250, 90)
49 (500, 36)
Disc
Lock Cap
206 (2,100, 152)
Brake Caliper
Cotter
Pin
Cotter Pin
Lower Suspension
Bushing Stopper
Lower Ball joint
294 (3,000, 217)
206 (2,100, 152)
206 (2,100, 152)
Lower Suspension Arm
127 (1,300, 94)
127 (1,300, 94)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F06530
Author:
Date:
1984
SA–34
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SA07N–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
2.
REMOVE FLEXIBLE HOSE AND ABS SPEED SENSOR WIRE HARNESS (w/ ABS) AND CLAMP FROM
SHOCK ABSORBER
Remove the bolt, flexible hose and ABS wire harness clamp.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
3.
DISCONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK FROM SHOCK
ABSORBER (See page SA–48)
4.
DISCONNECT SHOCK ABSORBER FROM STEERING
KNUCKLE
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and bolts on the lower side of the
shock absorber.
Torque: 211 N·m (2,150 kgf·cm, 156 ft·lbf)
(b) Remove the shock absorber from the steering knuckle.
HINT:
At the time of installation, coat the nut’s threads with engine oil.
5.
REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
Remove the 3 nuts, suspension support No.2 and shock absorber with the coil spring.
Torque: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation rotate the suspension support and set
it in the direction, as shown in the illustration.
To Outside
Z19346
Author:
Date:
1985
SA–35
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SA07O–01
DISASSEMBLY
SST
SST
W03198
REMOVE COIL SPRING
(a) Install 2 nuts and a bolt to the bracket at the lower portion
of the shock absorber and secure it in a vise.
(b) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727–30021
NOTICE:
When holding the shock absorber with the coil spring
removed, do not hold it by the spring lower seat. Also,
do not knock the spring lower seat.
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the SST.
HINT:
Use 2 of the same type of SST.
(c)
SST
(d)
W03199
Using SST to hold the suspension support, remove the
nut.
SST 09729–22031
Remove these parts from the shock absorber:
Suspension support
Bearing
Spring upper seat
Upper insulator
Coil spring
Lower insulator
Spring bumper
Author:
Date:
1986
SA–36
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SA07P–01
INSPECTION
INSPECT SHOCK ABSORBER
Compress and extend the shock absorber rod and check that
there is no abnormal resistance or unusual operation sound.
NOTICE:
When discarding the shock absorber, see DISPOSAL on
page SA–37.
W03646
Author:
Date:
1987
SA–37
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SA0II–01
DISPOSAL
1.
FULLY EXTEND SHOCK ABSORBER ROD
2.
DRILL HOLE TO REMOVE GAS FROM CYLINDER
Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder as shown in the illustration to remove the gas inside.
CAUTION:
The discharged gas is harmless, but be careful of chips
which may fly up when drilling.
W03648
Author:
Date:
1988
SA–38
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SA07R–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
SST
W03200
W03201
INSTALL LOWER INSULATOR ONTO SHOCK ABSORBER
2.
INSTALL SPRING BUMPER TO PISTON ROD
3.
INSTALL COIL SPRING
(a) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727–30021
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the SST.
HINT:
Use 2 of the same type of SST.
(b) Install the coil spring to the shock absorber.
HINT:
Fit the lower end of the coil spring into the gap of the spring lower seat.
4.
INSTALL SPRING UPPER SEAT AND INSULATOR
(a) Align the ’OUT’ mark of spring upper seat with the mark
of the upper insulator.
(b) Install the spring upper seat with upper insulator to the
shock absorber with the mark facing the outside of the vehicle.
(c) Install the bearing and suspension support.
(d)
SST
W03199
Using SST to hold the suspension support, install a new
nut.
SST 09729–22031
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
(e) Remove the SST from the coil spring.
SST 09727–30021
NOTICE:
Check that the bearing fits into the recess in the suspension support.
Author:
Date:
1989
SA–39
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
SA07S–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–34).
AFTER INSTALLATION, CHECK FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SA–4)
Author:
Date:
1990
SA–40
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
FRONT LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
SA07T–04
COMPONENTS
80 (820, 59)
49 (500, 36)
Suspension
Support No. 2
Suspension Support
Bearing
Spring Bumper
Spring
Upper Seat
Lower
Insulator
Upper
Insulator
Stabilizer Bar
Link
39 (400, 29)
Shock Absorber
with Coil Spring
Coil Spring
211 (2,150, 156)
Shock
Absorber
Front Drive Shaft
ABS Speed Sensor
Wire Harness Clamp
Dust
Deflector
Tie Rod End
29 (300, 22)
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
Cotter Pin
107 (1,090, 79)
ABS Speed Sensor
123 (1,250, 90)
49 (500, 36)
Disc
Lock Cap
206 (2,100, 152)
Brake Caliper
Cotter
Pin
Cotter Pin
Lower Suspension
Bushing Stopper
Lower Ball joint
294 (3,000, 217)
206 (2,100, 152)
206 (2,100, 152)
Lower Suspension Arm
127 (1,300, 94)
127 (1,300, 94)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F06530
Author:
Date:
1991
SA–41
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
SA07U–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
2.
DISCONNECT LOWER SUSPENSION ARM FROM
LOWER BALL JOINT
Remove the 2 nuts and bolt.
Torque: 127 N·m (1,300 kgf·cm, 94 ft·lbf)
W03202
3.
(a)
REMOVE LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
Remove the 2 bolts on the front side of the lower suspension arm.
Torque: 206 N·m (2,100 kgf·cm, 152 ft·lbf)
(b)
Remove the bolt and nut on the rear side of the lower suspension arm.
Torque: 206 N·m (2,100 kgf·cm, 152 ft·lbf)
Remove the lower suspension arm.
Remove the lower suspension arm bushing stopper from
the lower suspension arm shaft.
W03203
(c)
(d)
W03204
Author:
Date:
1992
SA–42
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
SA07W–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–41).
AFTER INSTALLATION, CHECK FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SA–4)
Author:
Date:
1993
SA–43
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
SA07X–05
COMPONENTS
80 (820, 59)
49 (500, 36)
Suspension
Support No. 2
Suspension Support
Bearing
Spring Bumper
Spring
Upper Seat
Lower
Insulator
Upper
Insulator
Stabilizer Bar
Link
39 (400, 29)
Shock Absorber
with Coil Spring
Coil Spring
211 (2,150, 156)
Shock
Absorber
Front Drive Shaft
ABS Speed Sensor
Wire Harness Clamp
Dust
Deflector
Tie Rod End
29 (300, 22)
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
Cotter Pin
107 (1,090, 79)
ABS Speed Sensor
123 (1,250, 90)
49 (500, 36)
Disc
Lock Cap
206 (2,100, 152)
Brake Caliper
Cotter
Pin
Cotter Pin
Lower Suspension
Bushing Stopper
Lower Ball joint
294 (3,000, 217)
206 (2,100, 152)
206 (2,100, 152)
Lower Suspension Arm
127 (1,300, 94)
127 (1,300, 94)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F06530
Author:
Date:
1994
SA–44
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
SA07Y–01
REMOVAL
SST
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
(See page SA–10)
REMOVE LOWER BALL JOINT
Using a screwdriver, remove the dust deflector.
Remove the cotter pin and nut.
Using SST, remove the lower ball joint.
SST 09628–62011
R08859
Author:
Date:
1995
SA–45
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
SA07Z–01
INSPECTION
N00208
INSPECT BALL JOINT FOR ROTATION CONDITION
(a) As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud back and
forth 5 times, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque wrench, turn the nut continuously one turn
each 2 – 4 seconds and take the torque reading on the 5th
turn.
Turning torque:
1.0 – 3.4 N·m (10 – 35 kgf·cm, 8.7 – 30 in.·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1996
SA–46
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
SA080–01
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL LOWER BALL JOINT
Install the lower ball joint and tighten the nut.
Torque:123 N·m (1,250 kgf·cm, 90 ft·lbf)
Install a new cotter pin.
R08850
SST
SST
R08861
2.
INSTALL NEW DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a hammer, install a new dust deflector.
SST 09316–60011 (09316–00011, 09316–00041),
09608–32010
HINT:
Align the holes for the ABS speed sensor in the dust deflector
and steering knuckle.
3.
INSTALL STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
(See page SA–13)
4.
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page
DI–493 or DI–539) AND FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SA–4)
Author:
Date:
1997
SA–47
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SA081–01
COMPONENTS
19 (195, 14)
19 (195, 14)
Bracket
Stabilizer
Bar Link
Bushing
Bracket
Bushing
Stabilizer
Bar Link
39 (400, 29)
39 (400, 29)
Stabilizer Bar
39 (400, 29)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable torque
W03207
Author:
Date:
1998
SA–48
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SA082–01
REMOVAL
1.
W03208
REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
2.
REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BAR LINKS
Remove the 4 nuts and 2 links.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a 5 mm hexagon
wrench to hold the stud.
3.
W03209
REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT BRACKETS AND BUSHINGS
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 brackets and bushings.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Install the bushing to the inside of the bushing on the stabilizer
bar.
4.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR
Remove the stabilizer bar from the left hand side.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the pressure feed tube.
Author:
Date:
1999
SA–49
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SA083–01
INSPECTION
Z00340
INSPECT STABILIZER BAR LINK BALL JOINT FOR ROTATION CONDITION
(a) As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud back and
forth 5 times, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque wrench, turn the nut continuously one turn
each 2 – 4 seconds and take the torque reading on the 5th
turn.
Turning torque:
0.05 – 1.0 N·m (0.5 – 10 kgf·cm, 0.4 – 8.7 in.·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2000
SA–50
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SA084–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–48).
Author:
Date:
2001
SA–51
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE HUB
REAR AXLE HUB
SA085–01
COMPONENTS
DRUM BRAKE
29 (300, 22)
Flexible Hose
Rear Axle Hub
80 (820, 59)
O–Ring
Reused Nut : 196 (2,000, 145)
New Nut
: 255 (2,600, 188)
No.2 Lower
Suspension Arm
Hub Bolt
Brake Drum
Rear Axle
Carrier
181 (1,850, 134)
47 (475, 134)
No.1 Lower
Suspension Arm
Brake Caliper
ABS
Speed Sensor
80 (820, 59)
O–Ring
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
113 (1,150, 83)
Disc
Hub Bolt
Strut Rod
Rear Axle Hub
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
W03210
Author:
Date:
2002
SA–52
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE HUB
SA086–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
w/ DISC BRAKE:
REMOVE BRAKE CALIPER AND DISC
Remove the brake caliper and disc.
Torque: 47 N·m (475 kgf·cm, 34 ft·lbf)
Support the brake caliper securely.
w/ DRUM BRAKE:
REMOVE BRAKE DRUM
4.
R10948
CHECK BEARING BACKLASH AND AXLE HUB DEVIATION
(a) Using a dial indicator near the center of the axle hub and
check the backlash in the bearing shaft direction.
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the backlash exceeds the maximum, replace the axle hub with
the bearing.
(b) Using a dial indicator, check the deviation at the surface
of the axle hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the deviation exceeds the maximum, replace the axle hub
with the bearing.
5.
(a)
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB
Remove the 4 bolts and rear axle hub.
Torque: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
Remove the O–ring.
(b)
HINT:
At the time of installation, coat a new O–ring with MP grease.
Z00206
Author:
Date:
2003
SA–53
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
(c)
(d)
6.
7.
(a)
A
A
B
W03211
–
REAR AXLE HUB
w/ Drum brake:
Remove the bolt, and disconnect the flexible hose from
the shock absorber.
Torque: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
Support the backing plate securely.
w/ ABS:
REMOVE ABS SPEED SENSOR
Torque: 8.0 N·m (82 kgf·cm, 71 in.·lbf)
REMOVE REAR AXLE CARRIER
Loosen the 3 nuts.
Torque:
Nut A:
Reused nut: 196 N·m (2,000 kgf·cm, 145 ft·lbf)
New nut: 255 N·m (2,600 kgf·cm, 188 ft·lbf)
Nut B: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
If reusing the 2 nuts, coat the nut’s threads with engine oil.
After stabilizing the suspension, torque the nuts.
(b)
R11165
Remove the bolt and nut, and disconnect the strut rod
from the rear axle carrier.
NOTICE:
When removing/installing bolt, stop the nut from rotating
and loosen/torque the bolt.
Torque: 113 N·m (1,150 kgf·cm, 83 ft·lbf)
(c) Remove the 2 nuts and bolts on the lower side of the
shock absorber.
(d) Remove the nut, bolt and No.2 lower suspension arm.
(e) Remove the rear axle carrier.
Author:
Date:
2004
SA–54
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE HUB
SA087–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–52).
AFTER INSTALLATION, CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page DI–493 or DI–539) AND
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SA–7)
Author:
Date:
2005
SA–55
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR WHEEL HUB BOLT
REAR WHEEL HUB BOLT
SA088–01
REPLACEMENT
SST
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR DISC OR DRUM (See page SA–52)
3.
REMOVE HUB BOLT
Using SST, remove the hub bolt.
SST 09628–10011
Z00212
4.
INSTALL HUB BOLT
Install a washer and nut to the hub bolt, as shown in the illustration, and install the hub bolt by tightening the nut.
5.
INSTALL REAR DISC OR DRUM
6.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
Z00213
Author:
Date:
2006
SA–56
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA089–01
COMPONENTS
Rear Side Seatback
49 (500, 36)
Suspension
Support
Coil Spring
Spring Bumper
Cap
39 (400, 29)
18 (185, 13)
Lower Insulator
Stabilizer Bar link
Shock Absorber
Assembly
Shock Absorber
5.5 (56, 49 in.·lbf)
ABS Wire Harness
39 (400, 29)
Reused nut : 196 (2,000, 145)
New nut :
255 (2,600, 188)
29 (300, 22)
Flexible Hose
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
W03212
Author:
Date:
2007
SA–57
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA08A–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK
(See page BO–113 or BO–118)
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
3.
REMOVE FLEXIBLE HOSE AND ABS SPEED SENSOR WIRE HARNESS (w/ ABS) FROM SHOCK ABSORBER
Remove the 2 bolts, flexible hose bracket and ABS wire harness clamp.
Torque:
Flexible hose: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
ABS wire: 5.5 N·m (56 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
R00749
4.
5.
(a)
R10288
W03213
DISCONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK FROM SHOCK
ABSORBER (See page SA–70)
REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
Loosen the 2 nuts on the lower side of the shock absorber.
Torque:
Reused nut: 196 N·m (2,000 kgf·cm, 145 ft·lbf)
New nut: 255 N·m (2,600 kgf·cm, 188 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, coat the nut’s threads with engine oil.
(b) Support the rear axle carrier with a jack.
(c) Remove the cap.
(d) Loosen the nut in the middle of the suspension support.
NOTICE:
Do not remove it.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
(e) Remove the 3 nuts of the suspension support.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
(f)
Lower the rear axle carrier and remove the 2 bolts.
(g) Remove the shock absorber with the coil spring.
Author:
Date:
2008
SA–58
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA08B–01
DISASSEMBLY
SST
W03214
REMOVE COIL SPRING
(a) Install 2 nuts and a bolt to the bracket at the lower part of
the shock absorber and secure it in a vise.
(b) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the SST.
SST 09727–30021
(c) Remove the suspension support nut.
(d) Remove these parts from the shock absorber:
Suspension support
Coil spring
Lower insulator
Spring bumper
Author:
Date:
2009
SA–59
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA08C–01
INSPECTION
INSPECT SHOCK ABSORBER
Compress and extend the shock absorber rod and check that
there is no abnormal resistance or unusual operation sound.
NOTICE:
When discarding the shock absorber, see DISPOSAL on
page SA–60.
W03646
Author:
Date:
2010
SA–60
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA0IJ–01
DISPOSAL
1.
FULLY EXTEND SHOCK ABSORBER ROD
2.
DRILL HOLE TO REMOVE GAS FROM CYLINDER
Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder as shown in the illustration to remove the gas inside.
CAUTION:
The discharged gas is harmless, but be careful of chips
which may fly up when drilling.
W03647
Author:
Date:
2011
SA–61
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA08E–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
2.
3.
(a)
INSTALL LOWER INSULATOR
INSTALL SPRING BUMPER TO PISTON ROD
INSTALL COIL SPRING
Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727–30021
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage the SST.
SST
R00911
(b) Install the coil spring to the shock absorber.
HINT:
Fit the lower end of the coil spring into the gap of the spring lower seat.
R00912
4.
(a)
I
(b)
Outside
(c)
R00823
INSTALL SUSPENSION SUPPORT
Install the suspension support to the piston rod and temporarily tighten a new nut.
Rotate the suspension support and set it in the direction
shown in the illustration.
Remove the SST.
SST 09727–30021
HINT:
After removing SST, again check the direction of the suspension support.
Author:
Date:
2012
SA–62
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA08F–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–57).
AFTER INSTALLATION, CHECK REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SA–7)
Author:
Date:
2013
SA–63
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
SA08G–01
COMPONENTS
Suspension member
Suspension Member Lower Stopper
No.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
RH
LH
56 (570, 41)
56 (570, 41)
51 (520, 38)
38 (390, 28)
51 (520, 38)
Adjusting
Tube
Suspension Member
Lower Stopper
Sub–Assembly
Adjusting
Tube
181 (1,850, 134)
Suspension Arm Washer
No.2 Lower Suspension Arm
181 (1,850, 134)
No.1 Lower Suspension Arm
113 (1,150, 83)
Parking Brake Cable
39 (400, 29)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
Parking Brake
Cable Clamp
Stabilizer Bar Link
Stabilizer Bar
Strut Rod
113 (1,150, 83)
Stabilizer
Bar Link
Bushing
Clip
Heat Insulator
Gasket
Bracket
Bushing
Bracket
19 (195, 14)
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Exhaust Center Pipe
56 (570, 41)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable torque
W03215
Author:
Date:
2014
SA–64
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
SA08H–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
(a)
(b)
W03216
Rear
B
A
A
W03219
REMOVE NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
Remove the 3 nuts, suspension arm washer and washers.
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installtion, after stabilizing the suspension, torque
the nuts.
(b) Remove the No.2 lower suspension arm.
HINT:
At the time of installtion, face the paint mark to the rearward.
5.
REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BRACKETS
(See page SA–70)
6.
(a)
(b)
B
REMOVE STRUT ROD
Remove the bolt and disconnect the parking brake cable.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
Remove the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 113 N·m (1,150 kgf·cm, 83 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installtion,after stabilizing the suspension, torque
the bolts.
(c) Remove the strut rod.
4.
(a)
W03217
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
REMOVE EXHAUST CENTER PIPE
5S–FE Engine: (See page EM–114)
1MZ–FE Engine: (See page EM–111)
(c)
REMOVE NO.1 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
Support the suspension member with a jack.
Remove the 4 nuts, 2 bolts and suspension member lower stoppers.
Torque:
Bolt: 51 N·m (520 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
Nut A: 51 N·m (520 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
Nut B: 38 N·m (390 kgf·cm, 28 ft·lbf)
Lower the suspension member.
Author:
Date:
2015
SA–65
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
(d)
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
Remove the No.1 lower suspension arm with the 2 bolts
and washer.
HINT:
At the time of installtion, face the paint mark to the rearward.
Rear
W03220
Author:
Date:
2016
SA–66
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
SA08I–01
DISASSEMBLY
DISASSEMBLE NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Loosen the 2 lock nuts.
(b) Turn and disassemble the No.2 lower suspension arm.
(c) Remove the lock nuts from the No.2 lower suspension
arm.
W03221
Author:
Date:
2017
SA–67
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
SA08J–01
REASSEMBLY
ASSEMBLE NO.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
(a) Install the 2 lock nuts to the No.2 lower suspension arm.
(b) Turn the adjusting tube and assemble the No.2 lower suspension arm.
W03222
HINT:
When assembling the No.2 lower suspension arm, make sure
that the length of A and B shown in the illustration is the same.
Maximum difference: 3.0 mm (0.118 in.)
A
B
W03223
(c)
Adjust the No.2 lower suspension arm length by turning
the adjusting tube.
Arm length: 512.3 mm (20.169 in.)
Temporarily tighten the 2 lock nuts.
(d)
HINT:
After adjusting the rear wheel alignment, torque the lock nuts
(See page SA–7).
Torque: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
W03224
Author:
Date:
2018
SA–68
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
SA08K–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–64).
AFTER INSTALLATION, CHECK REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SA–7)
Author:
Date:
2019
SA–69
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR STABILIZER BAR
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SA08L–01
COMPONENTS
Suspension member
Suspension Member Lower Stopper
No.2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
RH
LH
56 (570, 41)
56 (570, 41)
51 (520, 38)
38 (390, 28)
51 (520, 38)
Adjusting
Tube
Suspension Member
Lower Stopper
Sub–Assembly
Adjusting
Tube
181 (1,850, 134)
Suspension Arm Washer
No.2 Lower Suspension Arm
181 (1,850, 134)
No.1 Lower Suspension Arm
113 (1,150, 83)
Parking Brake Cable
39 (400, 29)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
Parking Brake
Cable Clamp
Stabilizer Bar Link
Stabilizer Bar
Strut Rod
113 (1,150, 83)
Stabilizer
Bar Link
Bushing
Clip
Heat Insulator
Gasket
Bracket
Bushing
Bracket
19 (195, 14)
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Exhaust Center Pipe
56 (570, 41)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable torque
W03215
Author:
Date:
2020
SA–70
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SA08M–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEELS
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
2.
REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT STABILIZER BAR LINKS
Remove the 4 nuts and 2 links.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a 5 mm hexagon
wrench to hold the stud.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
3.
REMOVE HEAT INSULATOR
Remove the 3 bolts, clip and heat insulator.
W03225
4.
REMOVE LEFT AND RIGHT BRACKETS AND BUSHINGS
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 brackets and bushings.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, install the bushing to the portion outside the bushing on the stabilizer bar.
5.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR
W03226
Author:
Date:
2021
SA–71
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SA08N–01
INSPECTION
Z00340
INSPECT STABILIZER BAR LINK BALL JOINT FOR ROTATION CONDITION
(a) As shown in the illustration, flip the ball joint stud back and
forth 5 times, before installing the nut.
(b) Using a torque wrench, turn the nut continuously one turn
each 2 – 4 seconds and take the torque reading on the 5th
turn.
Turning torque:
0.05 – 1.0 N·m (0.5 – 10 kgf·cm, 0.4 – 8.7 in.·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2022
SA–72
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SA08O–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page SA–70).
Author:
Date:
2023
SA–1
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Front:
SA1DP–03
INSPECTION
1.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
Vehicle height:
Tire size
Front*1 mm (in.)
205/65R15
218 (8.58)
Rear*2
mm (in.)
270 (10.63)
*1:
Front measuring point
Measure the distance from the ground to the center of the front
side lower suspension arm mounting bolt.
*2: Rear measuring point
Measure the distance from the ground to the center of the front
side strut rod mounting bolt.
NOTICE:
Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust the vehicle
height to the specified value.
If the vehicle height is not the specified value, try to adjust it by
pushing down on or lifting the body.
Rear:
F08080
2.
INSTALL CAMBER–CASTER–KINGPIN GAUGE OR
POSITION VEHICLE ON WHEEL ALIGNMENT TESTER
Follow the specific instructions of the equipment manufacturer.
3.
INSPECT CAMBER, CASTER AND STEERING AXIS
INCLINATION
Camber, caster and steering axis inclination:
Right–left error
–0°36’ ± 45’ (–0.6° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Right–left error
2°10’ ± 45’ (2.17° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Right–left error
13°01’ ± 45’ (13.02° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Camber
Z03382
Caster
Steering axis inclination
If the caster and steering axis inclination are not within the specified values, after the camber has been correctly adjusted, recheck the suspension parts for damaged and/or worn out parts.
4.
ADJUST CAMBER
NOTICE:
After the camber has been adjusted, inspect the toe–in.
(a) Remove the front wheel and ABS speed sensor clamp.
Author:
Date:
508
SA–2
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
(b)
–
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Remove the 2 nuts on the lower side of the shock absorber.
Coat the threads of the nuts with engine oil.
Temporarily install the 2 nuts.
(c)
(d)
F04031
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
HINT:
Adjust the camber by pushing or pulling the lower side of
the shock absorber in the direction in which the camber
adjustment is required.
Tighten the nuts.
Torque: 211 N·m (2,150 kgf·cm, 156 ft·lbf)
Install the ABS speed sensor clamp and front wheel.
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
Check the camber.
Try to adjust the camber to the center of the specified value.
Adjusting value for the set bolts is 6’ – 30’ (0.1° – 0.5°).
If the camber is not within the specified value, using the following table, estimate how much additional camber adjustment will
be required, and select the camber adjusting bolt.
1
2
Adjusting Bolt
Set Bolt
Bolt
90105–15001 90105–15004 90105–15005
90105–15006
1 Dot
3 Dots
F04048
Adjusting
Value
1
2
1
2
2 Dots
1
2
1
2
15’
30’
45’
1°00’
1°15’
1°30’
F01195
(i)
Do the steps mentioned above again. Between step (b)
and (c), replace 1 or 2 selected bolts.
HINT:
When replacing the 2 bolts, replace 1 bolt for each time.
Author:
Date:
509
SA–3
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
A
–
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
5.
INSPECT TOE–IN
Toe–in:
B
D
Toe–in
(total)
Front
A + B: 0° ± 12’ (0° ± 0.2°)
C – D: 0 ± 2 mm (0 ± 0.08 in.)
If the toe–in is not within the specified value, adjust it at the rack
ends.
6.
ADJUST TOE–IN
(a) Using pliers, remove the rack boot set clips.
C
SA3213
(b)
(c)
Loosen the tie rod end lock nuts.
Turn the right and left rack ends by an equal amount to
adjust the toe–in.
HINT:
Try to adjust the toe–in to the center of the specified value.
F02245
(d)
(e)
(f)
F02246
A
B
B
Make sure that the lengths of the right and left rack ends
are the same.
Rack end length difference: 1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
Torque the tie rod end lock nuts.
Torque: 74 N·m (750 kgf·cm, 54 ft·lbf)
Place the boots on the seats and using pliers, install the
clips.
HINT:
Make sure that the boots are not twisted.
7.
INSPECT WHEEL ANGLE
Turn the steering wheel fully, and measure the turning angle.
Wheel turning angle:
A
Front
Inside wheel
35°50’ ± 2° (35.84° ± 2°)
Outside wheel: Reference
31°28’ (31.47°)
If the right and left inside wheel angles differ from the specified
value, check the right and left rack end lengths.
A: Inside
B: Outside
SA0028
Author:
Date:
510
SA–4
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT AXLE HUB
FRONT AXLE HUB
SA07B–05
COMPONENTS
Front Shock Absorber
211 (2,150, 156)
Tie Rod End
Front Drive Shaft
107 (1,090, 79)
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
Brake Caliper
ABS Speed Sensor
Hub Bolt
Cotter pin
49 (500, 36)
Cotter pin
Lock Cap
Lower Suspension Arm
Disc
Snap Ring
294 (3,000, 217)
127 (1,300, 94)
Cotter pin
Steering Knuckle
Dust Deflector
Dust Cover
Bearing
123 (1,250, 90)
Axle Hub
Lower Ball Joint
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
8.3 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
F08042
Author:
Date:
511
SA–5
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
SA08P–02
COMPONENTS
Fender Apron Seal
Drive Shaft (RH)
Lock Bolt
32 (330, 24)
Fender Apron Seal
Snap Ring
Drive Shaft (LH)
Tie Rod End
Snap Ring
Boot Clamp
Lower
Suspension
Arm
49 (500, 36)
No. 2 Dust
Deflector
Cotter pin
Outbord Joint Shaft
RH:
127 (1,300, 94)
Lock Cap
Snap Ring
Boot
294 (3,000, 217)
Boot
LH:
Inboard Joint
Shaft
Tripod
Inboard Joint Shaft
Dust Cover
Snap Ring
Dust Cover
Center Bearing
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F03274
Author:
Date:
512
SA–6
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
SA1JR–01
REMOVAL
SST
FA1535
NOTICE:
The hub bearing could be damaged if it is subjected
to the vehicle weight, such as when moving the vehicle with the drive shaft removed.
Therefore, if it is absolutely necessary to place the vehicle weight on the hub bearing, first support it with
SST.
SST 09608–16042 (09608–02021, 09608–02041)
After disconnecting the drive shaft from the axle hub,
work carefully so as not to damage the ABS speed
sensor rotor serration on the drive shaft.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL AND FRONT FENDER
APRON SEAL
2.
DRAIN ATF
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
(a)
REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT LOCK NUT
Remove the cotter pin and lock cap.
While applying the brakes, remove the nut.
DISCONNECT TIE ROD END FROM STEERING
KNUCKLE
Remove the cotter pin and nut.
W03093
(b)
Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the steering
knuckle.
SST 09610–20012
SST
W03094
5.
DISCONNECT LOWER SUSPENSION ARM FROM
LOWER BALL JOINT
Remove the bolt and 2 nuts, and disconnect the lower suspension arm from the lower ball joint.
W03095
SA–7
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
6.
(a)
DISCONNECT DRIVE SHAFT FROM AXLE HUB
Using a plastic hammer, disconnect the drive shaft from
the axle hub.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot and ABS speed sensor
rotor.
(b) Push the front axle hub toward the outside of the vehicle,
and separate the drive shaft from the axle hub.
W03142
7.
(a)
REMOVE LH DRIVE SHAFT
Using a hub nut wrench and wooden block or an equivalent, remove the drive shaft.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the snap ring from the inboard joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot and ABS speed sensor
rotor.
LH:
R00647
8.
REMOVE RH DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Remove the bearing lock bolt.
(b) Using pliers, remove the snap ring and drive shaft.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot and ABS speed sensor
rotor.
RH:
W03144
SA–8
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
SA1EA–02
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N00191
(d)
2.
(a)
B
A
(b)
(c)
CHECK DRIVE SHAFT
Check to see that there is no remarkable play in the outboard joint.
Check to see that the inboard joint slides smoothly in the
thrust direction.
Check to see that there is no remarkable play in the radial
direction of the inboard joint.
Check the boots for damage.
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMPS
Using pliers, pinch the claw A and B to compress the large
inboard joint boot clamp and remove it.
Using a side cutter, cut the small inboard joint boot clamp
and remove it.
Using a side cutter, cut the 2 outboard joint boot clamps
and remove them.
F06526
3.
(a)
Matchmarks
FA1615
Matchmarks
SA1443
REMOVE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
Place matchmarks on the tripod, inboard and outboard
joint shafts.
NOTICE:
Do not punch the marks.
(b) Remove the inboard joint shaft from the outboard joint
shaft.
4.
REMOVE TRIPOD
(a) Using a snap ring expander, remove the inboard joint side
snap ring.
(b) Using a snap ring expander, temporarily slide the outboard joint side snap ring toward the outboard joint side.
(c) Place matchmarks on the outboard joint shaft and tripod.
NOTICE:
Do not punch the marks.
(d) Using a brass bar and hammer, remove the tripod from
the outboard joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
(e) Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
SA–9
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
5.
REMOVE INBOARD AND OUTBOARD JOINT BOOTS
Slide out the 2 boots.
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the outboard joint.
6.
LH drive shaft:
REMOVE DUST COVER
Using SST and a press, remove the dust cover from the inboard
joint shaft.
SST 09950–00020
SST
R09716
7.
(a)
RH drive shaft:
DISASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
Using a press, remove the transaxle side dust cover from
the inboard joint shaft.
SA1446
(b)
(c)
Using SST and a press, remove the bearing side dust
cover.
SST 09950–00020
Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
(d)
(e)
Using a press, remove the bearing.
Remove the snap ring.
SST
R09717
SA1451
SA–10
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
8.
(a)
(b)
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
REMOVE NO. 2 DUST DEFLECTOR
Mount the outboard joint shaft in a soft jaw vise.
Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the No. 2 dust
deflector.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the ABS speed sensor rotor.
F06452
SA–11
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
SA1EB–02
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL NO. 2 DUST DEFLECTOR
Using SST and a press, install a new No. 2 dust deflector.
SST 09309–36010, 09316–20011
2.
RH drive shaft:
ASSEMBLE INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
(a) Install a new snap ring to the inboard joint shaft.
SST
R15532
Steel
Plate
(b)
(c)
Using a steel plate and press, install a new bearing.
Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
(d)
Using SST, an extension bar and press, install a new
bearing side dust cover.
SST 09506–35010
FA1888
1.0 mm
(0.039 in.)
HINT:
The clearance between the dust cover and the bearing should
be kept in the range shown in the illustration.
SST
→
→
FA1971
(e)
Steel Plate
Using a steel plate and press, install a new transaxle side
dust cover until the distance from the tip of the inboard
joint shaft to the dust cover falls within the specified value,
as shown in the illustration.
86 – 87mm
(3.39 – 3.43 in.)
FA1889
3.
LH drive shaft:
INSTALL DUST COVER
Using a press, install a new dust cover.
SA1459
SA–12
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
Inboard Joint Boot
Outboard Joint Boot
4.
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
TEMPORARILY INSTALL OUTBOARD AND INBOARD
JOINT BOOTS AND NEW BOOT CLAMPS
HINT:
Vinyl tape
F01747
Before installing the boots, wrap the spline of the outboard joint shaft with vinyl tape to prevent the boots from
being damaged.
Before installing the boots, place 3 new clamps to the
small boot ends and large boot end (outboard joint side).
5.
INSTALL TRIPOD
(a) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
(b) Place the beveled side of the tripod axial spline toward the
outboard joint.
(c) Align the matchmarks placed before removal.
(d) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap in the tripod to the outboard joint shaft.
NOTICE:
Do not tap the roller.
(e) Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
6.
INSTALL BOOT TO OUTBOARD JOINT
Before assembling the boot, pack the outboard joint and boot
with grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity (Color = Black):
100 – 120 g (3.5 – 4.2 oz.)
7.
INSTALL INBOARD JOINT SHAFT TO OUTBOARD
JOINT SHAFT
(a) Pack the inboard joint and boot with grease in the boot kit.
Grease capacity (Color = Yellow ocher):
125 – 155 g (4.4 – 5.5 oz.)
(b) Align the matchmarks placed before removal, and install
the inboard joint shaft to the outboard joint shaft.
(c) Temporarily install the boot to the inboard joint shaft.
8.
(a)
(b)
CHECK DRIVE SHAFT LENGTH
Make sure that the 2 boots are on the shaft groove.
Make sure that the 2 boots are not stretched or contracted
when the drive shaft is at standard length.
Drive shaft standard length:
R00764
LH
609.2 ± 2.0 mm (23.984 ± 0.079 in.)
RH
842.9 ± 2.0 mm (33.185 ± 0.079 in.)
SA–13
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
9.
(a)
(b)
C
10.
B
C’
A
(a)
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Large inboard joint boot clamp:
INSTALL BOOT CLAMP TO INBOARD JOINT SHAFT
BOOT
Place the large inboard joint boot clamp.
Using pliers, pinch the claw A and B to compress the
clamp and engage the claw C and C’.
Others:
INSTALL BOOT CLAMPS TO BOTH BOOTS
Secure the preplaced 3 clamps onto the boots.
F06527
(b)
Place SST onto the clamp.
SST 09521–24010
(c) Tighten the SST so that the clamp is pinched.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the SST.
SST
R10353
(d)
Clearance
11.
SST
A
B
C
F00616
Using SST, adjust the clearance of the clamp.
SST 09240–00020
Clearance:
A : 1.9 mm (0.075 in.) or less
B : 1.5 – 2.5 mm (0.059 – 0.098 in.)
C : 3.0 – 4.0 mm (0.118 – 0.157 in.)
CHECK DRIVE SHAFT (See page SA–8)
SA–14
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
SA1EC–02
INSTALLATION
1.
LH drive shaft:
INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT TO TRANSAXLE
(a) Install a new snap ring to the inboard joint shaft.
(b) Coat the gear oil to the inboard joint shaft and differential case sliding surface.
(c) Set the snap ring with opening side facing downward.
(d) Using a brass bar and hammer, install the drive shaft.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the dust cover of the drive shaft and oil seal lip of the transaxle.
HINT:
Whether the inboard joint shaft is in contact with the pinion shaft or not can be known from the sound or feeling when driving it in.
(e) Check that there is 2 – 3 mm (0.08 – 0.12 in.) of play in the axial direction.
(f)
Check that the drive shaft cannot be removed by hand.
2.
RH drive shaft:
INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT TO TRANSAXLE
(a) Install the drive shaft.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the dust cover of the drive shaft and oil seal lip of the transaxle.
(b) Using pliers, install a new snap ring.
(c) Install a new bearing lock bolt.
Torque: 32 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
3.
CONNECT DRIVE SHAFT TO AXLE HUB
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the boot and ABS speed sensor rotor.
4.
CONNECT LOWER SUSPENSION ARM TO LOWER BALL JOINT
Torque: 127 N·m (1,300 kgf·cm, 94 ft·lbf)
5.
CONNECT TIE ROD END TO STEERING KNUCKLE
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle.
(b) Install the nut and a new cotter pin.
If the holes for the cotter pin are not aligned, tighten the nut further up to 60°.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
6.
INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT LOCK NUT
(a) While applying brakes, install the nut.
Torque: 294 N·m (3,000 kgf·cm, 217 ft·lbf)
(b) Install the lock cap and a new cotter pin.
If the holes for the cotter pin are not aligned, tighten the nut further up to 60°.
7.
FILL AND CHECK ATF (See page DI–133)
8.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER APRON SEAL
9.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
10. CHECK FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SA–1)
11. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page DI–177)
SA–15
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
SA07X–06
COMPONENTS
80 (820, 59)
49 (500, 36)
Suspension
Support No. 2
Suspension Support
Bearing
Spring Bumper
Spring
Upper Seat
Lower
Insulator
Upper
Insulator
Stabilizer Bar
Link
39 (400, 29)
Shock Absorber
with Coil Spring
211 (2,150, 156)
Coil Spring
Shock
Absorber
Front Drive Shaft
Tie Rod End
ABS Speed Sensor
Wire Harness Clamp
Dust
Deflector
29 (300, 22)
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
Cotter Pin
107 (1,090, 79)
ABS Speed Sensor
123 (1,250, 90)
49 (500, 36)
Disc
Lock Cap
206 (2,100, 152)
Brake Caliper
Cotter
Pin
Cotter Pin
Lower Suspension
Bushing Stopper
Lower Ball joint
294 (3,000, 217)
206 (2,100, 152)
206 (2,100, 152)
Lower Suspension Arm
127 (1,300, 94)
127 (1,300, 94)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F08043
Author:
Date:
522
SA–16
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR AXLE HUB
REAR AXLE HUB
SA085–04
COMPONENTS
Reused Nut : 196 (2,000, 145)
New Nut
: 255 (2,600, 188)
No. 2 Lower
Suspension Arm
No. 1 Lower
Suspension Arm
Rear Axle
Carrier
181 (1,850, 134)
29 (300, 22)
Flexible Hose
80 (820, 59)
Rear Axle Hub
ABS
Speed Sensor
8.0 (82, 71 in.·lbf)
O–Ring
113 (1,150, 83)
Hub Bolt
Strut Rod
Brake Drum
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F08044
Author:
Date:
523
SA–17
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA1EZ–03
COMPONENTS
Rear Seatback
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
Rear Seat Cushion
Cap
49 (500, 36)
39 (400, 29)
Collar
Suspension
Support
Spring
Bumper
Stabilizer
Bar Link
Reused nut: 196 (2,000, 145)
New nut: 255 (2,600, 188)
Shock Absorber
with Coil Spring
39 (400, 29)
Coil Spring
Lower Insulator
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
ABS Speed Sensor
Wire Harness
Flexible
Hose
29 (300, 22)
Shock Absorber
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F08045
Author:
Date:
524
SA–18
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA08A–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK AND REAR SEAT CUSHION (See page BO–22)
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
3.
DISCONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE AND ABS SPEED
SENSOR WIRE HARNESS CLAMP FROM SHOCK ABSORBER
Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the flexible hose bracket
and ABS wire harness clamp.
F08046
4.
F08047
DISCONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK FROM SHOCK
ABSORBER
Remove the nut and stabilizer bar link.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a 5 mm hexagon
wrench to hold the stud.
5.
REMOVE SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
(a) Loosen the 2 nuts on the lower side of the shock absorber.
(b) Remove the cap.
(c) Loosen the nut in the center of the suspension support.
NOTICE:
Do not remove it.
HINT:
If not disassembling the shock absorber, it is not necessary to
loosen the nut.
(d) Remove the 3 nuts and shock absorber with the coil
spring.
F08081
SA–19
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
SA1F5–02
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
Install the 3 nuts and shock absorber with the coil spring.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Install the shock absorber with the coil spring, 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque:
Reused nut: 196 N·m (2,000 kgf·cm, 145 ft·lbf)
New nut: 255 N·m (2,600 kgf·cm, 188 ft·lbf)
HINT:
If reusing the 2 nuts, coat the threads of the 2 nuts with engine oil.
(c) Torque the nut in the center of the suspension support.
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
HINT:
If the shock absorber has not been disassembled, it is not necessary to torque the nut.
(d) Install the cap.
2.
CONNECT STABILIZER BAR LINK
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon (5 mm) wrench to hold the stud.
3.
CONNECT FLEXIBLE HOSE AND ABS SPEED SENSOR WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
Torque:
Flexible hose: 29 N·m (300 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
ABS speed sensor wire harness: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
4.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
5.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK AND REAR SEAT CUSHION (See page BO–25)
6.
CHECK REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See Pub. No. RM654U on page SA–7)
SA–20
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
SA1F6–02
COMPONENTS
Suspension Member
56 (570, 41)
Suspension
Arm Washer
Adjusting
Tube
181 (1,850, 134)
No. 2 Lower Suspension Arm
181 (1,850, 134)
113 (1,150, 83)
No. 1 Lower Suspension Arm
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
Strut Rod
113 (1,150, 83)
Parking Brake Cable
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
F08049
Author:
Date:
527
SA–21
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
SA1JS–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
REMOVE STRUT ROD
Remove the bolt and disconnect the parking brake cable.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, nuts and strut rod.
NOTICE:
Loossen the bolt since the nut cannot be rotated.
F08073
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NO. 2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
Remove the 3 nuts, suspension arm washer and washer.
Remove the No. 2 lower suspension arm and washer.
F08074
4.
REMOVE NO. 1 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
Remove the 2 bolts with the washer and No. 1 lower suspension
arm.
F08075
SA–22
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR LOWER SUSPENSION ARM AND STRUT ROD
SA1JT–01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 1 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
Install the No. 1 lower suspension arm, washer and 2 bolts.
HINT:
Face the paint mark to the rearward.
Rear
F08076
2.
(a)
Rear
INSTALL NO. 2 LOWER SUSPENSION ARM
Install the No. 2 lower suspension arm, washer and nut to
the axle carrier.
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
HINT:
(b)
F08051
(c)
Face the paint mark to the rearward.
After stabilizing the suspension, torque the nut.
Install the washer and connect the No. 2 lower suspension arm to the suspension member.
Install the suspension arm washer and 2 nuts.
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
HINT:
After stabilizing the suspension, torque the nut.
3.
F08050
INSTALL STRUT ROD
Torque: 113 N·m (1,150 kgf·cm, 83 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Torque the bolt since the nut cannot be rotated.
HINT:
After stabilizing the suspension, torque the bolt.
4.
CONNECT PARKING BRAKE CABLE
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
5.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
6.
CHECK REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See Pub. No. RM654U on page SA–7)
SA–23
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR STABILIZER BAR
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SA1FB–02
COMPONENTS
Stabilizer Bar
Stabilizer Bar Link
39 (400, 29)
39 (400, 29)
Bushing
19 (195, 14)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
19 (195, 14)
Stabilizer Bar Bracket
F08077
Author:
Date:
530
SA–24
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SA08M–02
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE RIGHT AND LEFT STABILIZER BAR LINKS
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and link.
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon (5 mm)
wrench to hold the stud.
(b) Employ the same manner described above to the other
side.
F08048
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
F08078
REMOVE RIGHT AND LEFT BRACKETS AND BUSHINGS
Remove the 2 bolts, bracket and bushings.
Employ the same manner described above to the other
side.
REMOVE STABILIZER BAR
SA–25
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
–
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SA1FE–02
INSTALLATION
Bushing
Stopper
F08079
1.
INSTALL STABILIZER BAR
2.
INSTALL RIGHT AND LEFT BUSHINGS AND STABILIZER BAR BRACKETS
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Install the bushing to the outside of the bushing stopper on the
stabilizer bar.
3.
INSTALL RIGHT AND LEFT STABILIZER BAR LINKS
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
HINT:
If the ball joint turns together with the nut, use a hexagon (5 mm)
wrench to hold the stud.
’99camry U
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–1
Overview of instruments
and controls
Instrument panel overview
Instrument cluster overview
Indicator symbols on the
instrument panel
1
’99camry U
Instrument panel overview
1. Rear view mirror remote control levers
2. Side defroster outlets
3. Side vents
4. Instrument cluster
5. Center vents
6. Glove box
7. Electric moon roof switch and
personal light
8. Garage door opener box or
miscellaneous box
9. Power door lock switches
10. Power window switches
11. Cup holders
12. Cup holder or rear ashtray
13. Parking brake lever
14. Automatic transmission selector lever
or manual transmission gear shift lever
15. Auxiliary box
16. Hood lock release lever
2
’99camry U
1. Power rear view mirror control switch
2. Headlight and turn signal switch
3. Wiper and washer switches
4. Clock
5. Emergency flasher switch
6. Car audio
7. Rear window and outside rear view
mirror defoggers switch
8. Air conditioning controls
9. Front ashtray
10. Power outlet
11. Cigarette lighter
12. Ignition switch
13. Cruise control switch
14. Tilt steering lock release lever
15. Traction control system off switch
16. Instrument panel light control knob
3
’99camry U
Instrument cluster overview
1. Engine coolant temperature gauge
4. Speedometer
7. Tachometer
2. Service reminder indicators and
indicator lights
5. Odometer and two trip meters
8. Trip meter reset knob
6. Theft deterrent system/Engine
immobiliser system indicator light
9. Low fuel level warning light
3. Fuel gauge
4
’99camry U
Indicator symbols on the instrument panel
(type A)
(type A)
Brake system warning light∗1
Anti-lock brake system warning light∗1
(type B)
(type B)
Seat belt reminder light∗1
Open door warning light∗1
Discharge warning light∗1
Rear light failure warning light∗1
Malfunction indicator lamp∗1
SRS airbag warning light∗1
Low oil pressure warning light∗1
Low windshield washer fluid level warning light∗1
5
’99camry U
Traction
light∗1
control
system
off
indicator/warning
Automatic transmission indicator lights
Slip indicator light
Turn signal indicator lights
Headlight high beam indicator light
∗1 :
∗2 :
Overdrive–off indicator light
Cruise control indicator light∗2
6
For details, see ”Service reminder indicators and warning
buzzers” in Chapter 1–5.
If this light flashes, see ”Cruise control” in Chapter 1–6.
’99camry U
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Keys (without engine
immobiliser system)
Chapter 1–2
Keys and Doors
Keys
Engine immobiliser system
Side doors
Power windows
Trunk lid
Hood
Theft deterrent system
Fuel tank cap
Electric moon roof
Your vehicle is supplied with two kinds
of key.
1. Master key—This key works in every
lock.
2. Sub key—This key will not work in the
glove box and trunk.
To protect things locked in the glove box
or trunk when you have your vehicle
parked, leave the sub key with the attendant.
KEY NUMBER PLATE
Your key number is shown on the plate.
Keep the plate in a safe place such as
your wallet, not in the vehicle.
If you should lose your keys or if you
need additional keys, duplicates can be
made by a Toyota dealer using the key
number.
We recommend you to write down the key
number and keep it in safe place.
Since the doors and trunk lid can be
locked without a key, you should always
carry a spare master key in case you
accidentally lock your keys inside the vehicle.
7
’99camry U
Keys (with engine
immobiliser system)
To protect things locked in the trunk when
you have your vehicle parked, leave the
sub key with the attendant.
Since the door can be locked without a
key, you should always carry a spare
master key in case you accidentally lock
your keys inside the vehicle.
Your vehicle is supplied with the two
kinds of key.
1. Master key (black)—This key works in
every lock. Your Toyota dealer will
need it to make you a new key with
built–in transponder chip.
2. Sub key (gray)—This key will not work
in the glove box and trunk.
The master key and sub key each have
a transponder chip in their key head
which is very important for the system
function, so be careful not to lose these
keys. If you make your own duplicate key,
you will not be able to cancel the system
or start the engine.
8
NOTICE
When using a key containing a transponder chip, observe the following
precautions:
When starting the engine, do not
use the key with a key ring resting
on the key grip and do not press
the key ring against the key grip.
Otherwise the engine may not start,
or may stop soon after it starts.
’99camry U
Do not cover the key grip with any
material that cuts off electromagnetic waves.
Do not knock the key hard against
other objects.
Do not leave the key exposed to
high temperatures for a long period,
such as on the dashboard and hood
under the direct sunlight.
Do not put the key in water or
wash it in an ultrasonic washer.
When starting the engine, do not
use the key with other transponder
keys around (including keys of other vehicles) and do not press other
key plates against the key grip.
Otherwise the engine may not start,
or may stop soon after it starts. If
this happens, remove the key once
and then insert it again after taking
off other transporter keys (including
keys of other vehicles) from the
ring or while gripping or covering
them with your hand to start the
engine.
Do not bend the key grip.
Do not use the key with electromagnetic materials.
9
’99camry U
Engine immobiliser system
KEY NUMBER PLATE
Your key number is shown on the plate.
Keep the plate in a safe place such as
your wallet, not in the vehicle.
If you should lose your keys or if you
need additional keys, duplicates can be
made by a Toyota dealer using the key
number.
We recommend you to write down the key
number and keep it in safe place.
The engine immobiliser system is a
theft prevention system. When you insert the key in the ignition switch, the
transporter chip in the key’s head
transmits an electronic code to the vehicle. The engine will start, only when
the electronic code in the chip corresponds to the registered ID code for
the vehicle.
The system is automatically set when the
key is removed from the ignition switch.
The indicator light will start flashing every
1 second to show the system is set.
If either of the following indicator conditions occurs, contact your Toyota dealer.
The indicator light stays on except
when the theft deterrent system is setting or activating. (See ”Theft deterrent
system”)
The indicator light does not start flashing when the key is removed from the
ignition switch.
The indicator light flashes unsteady.
10
’99camry U
Inserting the registered key in the ignition
switch automatically cancels the system,
which enables the engine to start. The
indicator light will go off.
For your Toyota dealer to make you a
new key with built–in transporter chip,
your dealer will need your key number
and master key. However, there is a limit
to the number of additional keys your
Toyota dealer can make for you.
If you make your own duplicate key,
you will not be able to cancel the system or start the engine.
For vehicles sold in U.S.A.
FCC ID: MOZ RI–4ATY
MADE IN JAPAN
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
For vehicles sold in Canada
This device complies with RSS–210 of
Industry Canada. Operation is subject to
the following two conditions:
(1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept
any interference, including interference
that may cause undesired operation of
the device.
CAUTION
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
11
’99camry U
Side doors
LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITH KEY
Insert the key into the keyhole and turn
it.
LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK BUTTON
Driver’s side
Move the lock button.
To lock: Turn the key forward.
To unlock: Turn the key backward.
To lock: Push the knob forward.
To unlock: Pull the knob backward.
Vehicles with power door lock system—All
the doors lock and unlock simultaneously
with either front door. In the driver’s door
lock, turning the key once will unlock the
driver’s door and twice in succession will
unlock all the doors simultaneously.
Closing the door with the lock knob in the
lock position will also lock the door. Be
careful not to lock your keys in the vehicle.
Vehicles with power door lock system—The door cannot be locked if you
leave the key in the ignition switch.
Passenger’s side
12
’99camry U
LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITH POWER DOOR LOCK SWITCH
CAUTION
Push the switch.
Before driving, be sure that the doors
are closed and locked, especially
when small children are in the vehicle. Along with the proper use of
seat belts, locking the doors helps
prevent the driver and passengers
from being thrown out from the vehicle during an accident. It also helps
prevent the doors from being opened
unintentionally.
To lock: Push the switch on the front side.
To unlock: Push the switch on the rear
side.
All the doors lock or unlock simultaneously.
REAR DOOR CHILD–PROTECTORS
Move the lock lever to the ”LOCK”
position as shown on the label.
This feature allows you to lock a rear
door so it can be opened from the outside
only, not from inside. We recommend using this feature whenever small children
are in the vehicle.
13
’99camry U
—Wireless remote control
Your vehicle has a wireless remote
control system that can lock or unlock
all the doors, or activate the theft
deterrent system from a distance within
approximately 1 m (3 ft.) of the vehicle.
LOCKING
DOORS
AND
UNLOCKING
THE
To lock and unlock all the doors, push
the switches of the transmitter slowly
and securely.
Locking operation
To lock: Push the ”LOCK” switch. All the
doors are locked simultaneously. At this
time, parking lights, side marker lights and
tail lights flash.
Check to see that the doors are securely
locked.
If any of the doors is not securely closed,
or if the key is in the ignition switch,
locking cannot be performed by the
”LOCK” switch.
To unlock: Push the ”UNLOCK” switch
once to unlock the driver’s door alone.
Pushing the switch twice within 3 seconds
unlocks all the doors simultaneously. At
this time, parking lights, side marker lights
and tail lights flash twice.
Unlocking operation
14
You have 30 seconds to open a door after
using the wireless remote unlock feature.
If a door is not opened by then, all the
doors will be automatically locked again.
If the ”LOCK” or ”UNLOCK” switch is kept
pressed in, the locking or unlocking operation is not repeated. Release the button
and then push again.
’99camry U
WIRELESS REMOTE CONTROL TRANSMITTER
The wireless remote control transmitter is
an electronic component. Observe the following instructions in order not to cause
damage to the transmitter.
Do not leave the transmitter on places
where the temperature becomes high
such as on the dashboard.
Do not disassemble it.
Avoid knocking it hard against other
objects or dropping it.
”PANIC” SWITCH
Pushing the ”PANIC” switch blows the
horn intermittently and flashes the
headlights and tail lights.
The ”PANIC” switch is used to deter vehicle theft when you witness anyone attempting to break into or damage your
vehicle.
The alarm will last for one minute. To stop
alarm midway, push the ”PANIC” switch
once again, unlock any door with the key
or transmitter, or turn the ignition key from
the ”LOCK” to ”ON” position.
The ”PANIC” mode does not work when
the key is inserted in the ignition switch.
Avoid putting it in water.
You can use up to 2 wireless remote control transmitters for the same vehicle.
Contact your Toyota dealer for detailed
information.
If the wireless remote control transmitter
does not actuate the doors or alarm, or
operate from a normal distance:
REPLACING TRANSMITTER BATTERIES
For replacement, use DURACELL DL2016
batteries or equivalent.
CAUTION
Special care should be taken that
small children do not swallow the removed transmitter batteries or components.
NOTICE
When replacing the terminal batteries,
be careful not to lose the components.
Replace the transmitter batteries by the
following procedures:
Check for closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station or an
airport which can interfere with normal
operation of the transmitter.
The batteries may have been consumed. Check the batteries in the
transmitter. To replace the batteries,
see ”Replacing transmitter batteries”.
15
’99camry U
1. Using a coin or equivalent, open the
transmitter case.
2. Remove the discharged transmitter batteries.
NOTICE
Do not bend the terminals.
3. Put new transmitter batteries with negative (–) side up.
Close the transmitter case securely.
NOTICE
Make sure the positive side and
negative side of the transmitter batteries should be faced correctly.
Be careful not to bend the electrode
of the transmitter batteries insertion
and that dust or oils do not adhere
to the transmitter case.
Close the transmitter case securely.
16
’99camry U
Power windows
After replacing batteries, check that the
transmitter operates properly. If the transmitter still does not operate properly, contact your Toyota dealer.
If you lose your transmitter, contact your
Toyota dealer as soon as possible to
avoid the possibility of theft, or an accident.
MODEL/FCC ID: GQ43VT7T
ISC: 1470 K1361
MADE IN U.S.A.
This complies with Part 15 of the FCC
rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) This device must
accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
The windows can be operated with the
switch on each door.
The power windows work when the ignition
switch is in the ”ON” position.
Key off operation: If both front doors are
closed, they work for 45 seconds even
after the ignition switch is turned off. They
stop working when either front door is
opened.
Automatic operation (to open only):
Push the switch completely down and then
release it. The window will fully open. To
stop the window partway, lightly pull the
switch up and then release it.
OPERATING THE DRIVER’S WINDOW
Use the switch on the driver’s door.
Normal operation: The window moves as
long as you hold the switch.
To open: Lightly push down the switch.
To close: Pull up the switch.
17
’99camry U
Window
lock
button
CAUTION
To avoid serious personal injury, you
must do the following.
Always make sure the head, hands
OPERATING
DOWS
THE
PASSENGERS’
WIN-
Use the switches on the passengers’
doors. The driver’s door also has
switches that control the passengers’
windows.
The window moves as long as you hold
the switch.
To open: Push down the switch.
To close: Pull up the switch.
If you push in the window lock button on
the driver’s door, the passengers’ windows
cannot be operated.
18
and other parts of the body of all
occupants are kept completely inside the vehicle before you close
the power windows. If someone’s
neck, head or hands gets caught in
a closing window, it could result in
a serious injury. When anyone
closes the power windows, be sure
that they operate the windows safely.
When small children are in the vehicle, never let them use the power
window switches without supervision. Use the window lock button to
prevent them from making unexpected use of the switches.
Never leave small children alone in
the vehicle, especially with the ignition key still inserted. They could
use the power window switches and
get trapped in a window. Unattended children can become involved in serious accidents.
’99camry U
Trunk lid—
—Lock release lever
CAUTION
Keep the trunk lid closed while driving. This not only keeps the luggage
from being thrown out but also prevents exhaust gases from entering
the vehicle.
To open the trunk lid from the outside,
insert the master key and turn it clockwise.
To open the trunk lid from the driver’s
seat, pull up on the lock release lever.
See ”Luggage stowage precautions” in
Part 2 for precautions to observe for loading luggage.
To close the trunk lid, lower it and press
down on it. After closing the trunk lid, try
pulling it up to make sure it is securely
closed.
19
’99camry U
—Luggage security system
This system deactivates the lock release lever so that things locked in the
trunk can be protected.
1. Push down the security lock levers
to lock the rear seatbacks.
On vehicles with built–in child restraint,
only the left seatback has a lock lever
and can be lowered. The right seatback
cannot be folded down.
After locking the rear seatbacks, try folding them down to make sure they are
securely locked, otherwise someone could
get into the trunk by folding down a rear
seat.
20
Hood
2. After closing the trunk lid, insert the
master key and turn it counterclockwise to deactivate the lock release
lever.
After closing the trunk lid, try pulling it up
to make sure it is securely locked.
To open the hood:
1. Pull the hood lock release lever. The
hood will spring up slightly.
CAUTION
Before driving, be sure that the hood
is closed and securely locked. Otherwise, the hood may open unexpectedly while driving and an accident may
occur.
’99camry U
Theft deterrent system
2. In front of the vehicle, pull up the
auxiliary catch lever and lift the
hood.
3. Hold the hood open by inserting the
support rod into the slot.
Before closing the hood, check to see that
you have not forgotten any tools, rags,
etc. and return the support rod to its
clipthis prevents rattles. Then lower the
hood make sure it locks into place. If
necessary, press down gently on the front
edge to lock it.
To deter the vehicle theft, The system
is designed to give an alarm if any of
the doors, trunk or hood is forcibly unlocked or the battery terminal is disconnected and then reconnected when the
vehicle is locked.
The alarm blows the horn intermittently
and flashes the headlights and tail lights.
CAUTION
After inserting the support rod into
the slot, make sure the rod supports
the hood securely from falling down
on to your head or body.
21
’99camry U
The system will automatically be set after
30 seconds. When the system is set, the
indicator light will start flashing again.
4. After making sure the indicator light
starts flashing, you may leave the vehicle.
Never leave anyone in the vehicle when
you set the system, because unlocking
from the inside will activate the system.
WHEN THE SYSTEM IS SET
Activating the system
SETTING THE SYSTEM
1. Turn the ignition key to the ”LOCK”
position and remove it.
The system will give the alarm under the
following conditions:
If any of the doors is unlocked or if
the trunk or hood is forcibly opened
without the key or wireless remote control transmitter
The indicator light will start flashing every
1 second when the key is removed from
the
ignition
switch.
(See
”Engine
immobiliser system” for details.)
If the battery terminal is disconnected
2. Have all passengers get out of the
vehicle.
The indicator light will come on when the
system is activating.
3. Close and lock all the doors, trunk and
hood.
The indicator light will come on when all
the doors, trunk and hood are closed and
locked.
22
and then reconnected
If any of the door is unlocked without the
key or wireless remote control transmitter
and the key is not in the ignition switch,
all the doors will be automatically locked
again.
After one minute, the alarm will automatically stop and the indicator light will starts
flashing again.
Reactivating the alarm
Once set, the system automatically resets
the alarm after the alarm stops.
The alarm will activate again under the
same
circumstances
described
in
”Activating the system”.
Stopping the alarm
The alarm will be stopped by the following
three ways:
Turn the ignition key from the ”LOCK”
to ”ON” position.
Unlock any of the doors with the key
or wireless remote control transmitter.
Open the trunk with the key.
These ways cancel the system at the
same time.
’99camry U
Fuel tank cap
TESTING THE SYSTEM
1. Open all the windows.
2. Set the system as described above.
The doors should be locked with the
key or wireless remote control transmitter. Be sure to wait until the indicator
light goes off or starts flashing.
3. Unlock any door from the inside. The
system should activate the alarm.
4. Stopping the alarm as described above.
5. Repeat this operation for the other
doors, trunk and hood. When testing on
the hood, also check that the system
is activated when the battery terminal
is disconnected and then reconnected.
If the system does not work properly,
have it checked by your Toyota dealer.
1. To open the fuel filler door, pull the
lever up.
When refueling, turn off the engine.
CAUTION
Do not smoke, cause sparks or allow open flames when refueling.
The fumes are flammable.
When opening the cap, do not remove the cap quickly. In hot weather, fuel under pressure could cause
injury by spraying out of the filler
neck if the cap is suddenly removed.
2. To remove the fuel tank cap, turn
the cap slowly counterclockwise,
then pause slightly before removing
it. After removing the cap, hang it
on the cap hanger.
It is not unusual to hear a slight swoosh
when the cap is opened. When installing,
turn the cap clockwise till you hear a
click.
If the cap is not tightened securely, the
malfunction indicator lamp comes on.
Make sure the cap is tightened securely.
23
’99camry U
Electric moon roof
The indicator lamp goes off after driving
several times. If the indicator lamp does
not go off, contact your Toyota dealer as
soon as possible.
To operate the moon roof, use the
switches beside the personal light.
The moon roof works when the ignition
switch is in the ”ON” position. However,
if all the doors are closed, it works for 45
seconds even after the ignition switch is
turned off. It stops working when any of
the doors is opened.
CAUTION
Make sure the cap is tightened securely to prevent fuel spillage in
case of an accident.
Sun shade operation—
The sun shade can be opened or closed
by hand.
Use only a genuine Toyota fuel tank
cap for replacement. It has a built–
in check valve to reduce fuel tank
vacuum.
Sliding operation—
Sliding operation
To open: Push the switch on the ”SLIDE
OPEN” side.
The roof will fully open. To stop the roof
partway, push the switch on either the
”SLIDE OPEN” or ”TILT UP” side briefly.
The sun shade will be opened together
with the roof.
To close: Push the switch on the ”TILT
UP” side.
As a precaution when closing, the roof
stops at the three–quarters closed position
before fully closing. Therefore, release the
switch and then push it again to close it
completely.
Tilting operation
24
’99camry U
Tilting operation—
To tilt up: Push the switch on the ”TILT
UP” side.
To lower: Push the switch on the ”SLIDE
OPEN” side.
You may stop the moon roof at any desired position. The roof will move while
the switch is being pushed and stop when
released except to slide open.
CAUTION
To avoid serious personal injury, you
must do the following.
While the vehicle is moving, always
keep the head, hands and other
parts of the body of all occupants
away from the roof opening. Otherwise, you could be seriously injured
if the vehicle stops suddenly or if
the vehicle is involved in an accident.
Always make sure nobody places
his/her head, hands and other parts
of the body in the roof opening before you close the roof. If someone’s neck, head or hands gets
caught in the closing roof, it could
result in a serious injury. When
anyone closes the roof, first make
sure it is safe to do so.
Never leave small children alone in
the vehicle,e specially with the ignition key still inserted. They could
use the moon roof switches and get
trapped in the roof opening. Unattended children can become involved in serious accidents.
Never sit on top of the vehicle
around the roof opening.
25
’99camry U
26
’99camry U
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–3
Seats, Seat belts,
Steering wheel and
Mirrors
Seats
Front seats
Fold–down rear seat
Head restraints
Seat belts
Seats
Anti–glare inside rear view
mirror
Sun visors
While the vehicle is being driven, all vehicle occupants should have the seatback
upright, sit well back in the seat and properly wear the seat belts provided.
CAUTION
Do not drive the vehicle unless the
occupants are properly seated. Do
not allow sitting on top of a
folded–down seatback, or in the
luggage compartment. Persons not
properly seated and not properly restrained by seat belts can be severely injured in the event of emergency braking or a collision.
During driving, do not allow passengers to stand up or move
around between seats. Severe injuries can occur in the event of emergency braking or a collision.
SRS driver and front passenger
airbags
SRS side airbags
Child restraint
Tilt steering wheel
Outside rear view mirrors
27
’99camry U
Front seats—
—Front seat precautions
(with SRS side airbags)
CAUTION
The SRS side airbags are installed in
the driver and front passenger seats.
Observe the following precautions.
Do not lean against the front door
when the vehicle is in use. The side
airbag inflates with considerable
speed and force; you may be killed
or seriously injured.
Do not modify or replace the seats
or surface of the front seats with
the side airbags. Such changes may
disable the system or cause the
side airbags to inflate, resulting in
death or serious injury. Consult
your Toyota dealer.
Do not use accessories for the
seats which cover the parts where
the side airbags should inflate.
Such accessories may prevent the
side airbags from activating correctly, causing death or serious injury.
28
—Seat adjustment
precautions
Adjust the driver’s seat so that the foot
pedals, steering wheel and instrument
panel controls are within easy reach of
the driver.
CAUTION
Adjustments should not be made
while the vehicle is moving, as the
seat may unexpectedly move and
cause the driver to lose control of
the vehicle.
When adjusting the seat, be careful
not to hit the seat against a passenger or luggage.
After adjusting the seat position,
try sliding it forward and backward
to make sure it is locked in position.
After adjusting the seatback, exert
body pressure to make sure it is
locked in position.
Do not put objects under the seats.
The objects may interfere with the
seat–lock mechanism or unexpectedly push up the seat position adjusting lever; the seat may suddenly
move, causing the driver to lose
control of the vehicle.
While adjusting the seat, do not put
your hands under the seat or near
the moving parts. You may catch
and injure your hands or fingers.
’99camry U
—Adjusting front seats
(manual seat)
1. SEAT POSITION ADJUSTING LEVER
Pull the lever up. Then slide the seat
to the desired position with slight body
pressure and release the lever.
2. SEATBACK
LEVER
ANGLE
ADJUSTING
3. SEAT CUSHION HEIGHT ADJUSTING
KNOB
Turn the knob either way.
4. SEAT LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTING LEVER
Pull the lever upward or downward.
Lean forward and pull the lever up.
Then lean back to the desired angle
and release the lever.
CAUTION
To reduce the risk of sliding under
the lap belt during a collision, avoid
reclining the seatback any more than
needed. The seat belts provide maximum protection in a frontal or rear
collision when the driver and the passenger are sitting up straight and
well back in the seats. If you are
reclined, the lap belt may slide past
your hips and apply restraint forces
directly to the abdomen. Therefore, in
the event of a frontal collision, the
risk of personal injury may increase
with increasing recline of the seatback.
29
’99camry U
—Adjusting front seats
(power seat)
1. SEAT POSITION AND SEAT CUSHION
HEIGHT ADJUSTING SWITCH
Move the control switch in the desired
direction.
Releasing the switch will stop the seat at
that position.
Do not place anything under the front
seats. It might interfere with the seat–lock
mechanism.
2. SEATBACK
SWITCH
ANGLE
ADJUSTING
Move the control switch in the desired
direction.
Releasing the switch will stop the seatback at that position.
CAUTION
To reduce the risk of sliding under
the lap belt during a collision, avoid
reclining the seatback any more than
needed. The seat belts provide maximum protection in a frontal or rear
collision when the driver and the passenger are sitting up straight and
well back in the seats. If you are
reclined, the lap belt may slide past
your hips and apply restraint forces
directly to the abdomen. Therefore, in
the event of a formal collision, the
risk of personal injury may increase
with increasing recline of the seatback.
3. SEAT LUMBAR SUPPORT ADJUSTING LEVER
Pull the lever upward or downward
30
’99camry U
Fold–down rear seat
CAUTION
When returning the seatback to the
upright position:
Make sure the seat belts are not
twisted or caught in the seatback
and are arranged in the proper
position and are ready to use.
Make sure the seatback is securely
locked by pushing forward and rearward on the top of the seatback.
1. Pull up the seatback security lock
lever 1 to the unlock position.
2. Pull up the lock release button 2.
3. Fold down the seatback.
Each seatback may be folded separately.
On vehicles with built–in child restraint,
only the left seatback can be folded down.
This will enlarge the trunk as far as the
seatbacks. See ”Luggage stowage precautions” in Part 2 for precautions to observe
for loading luggage.
NOTICE
Make sure the luggage loaded in the
enlarged trunk will not damage the
webbing of the rear center seat belt
when the left seatback is folded
down.
31
’99camry U
Seat belts—
—Seat belt precautions
Head restraints
For your safety and comfort, adjust the
head restraint before driving.
To raise: Pull it up.
To lower: Push it down while pressing the
lock release button.
On some models, you can also move the
head restraint forward or backward. If
such adjustment is desired, pull or push
on the top of the head restraint.
Front
The head restraint is most effective when
it is close to your head. Therefore, using
a cushion on the seatback is not recommended.
CAUTION
Adjust the center of the head restraint so that it is closest to the
top of your ears.
After adjusting the head restraint,
make sure it is locked in position.
Do not drive with the head restraints removed.
Rear
32
Toyota strongly urges that the driver and
passengers in the vehicle be properly restrained at all times with the seat belts
provided. Failure to do so could increase
the chance of injury and/or the severity of
injury in accidents.
Child. Use a child restraint system appropriate for the child until the child becomes large enough to properly wear the
vehicle’s seat belts. See ”Child restraint”
for details.
If a child is too large for a child restraint
system, the child should sit in the rear
seat and must be restrained using the
vehicle’s seat belt. According to accident
statistics, the child is safer when properly
restrained in the rear seat than in the
front seat.
If a child must sit in the front seat, the
seat belts should be worn properly. If an
accident occurs and the seat belts are not
worn properly, the force of the rapid inflation of the airbag may cause death or
serious injury to the child.
’99camry U
Do not allow the child to stand up or
kneel on either rear or front seats. An
unrestrained child could suffer serious injury or death during emergency braking or
a collision. Also, do not let the child sit
on your lap. It does not provide sufficient
restraint.
Pregnant woman. Toyota recommends the
use of a seat belt. Ask your doctor for
specific recommendations. The lap belt
should be worn securely and as low as
possible over the hips and not on the
waist.
Injured person. Toyota recommends the
use of a seat belt. Depending on the injury, first check with your doctor for specific
recommendations.
CAUTION
Persons should ride in their seats
properly wearing their seat belts
whenever the vehicle is moving.
Otherwise, they are much more likely
to suffer serious bodily injury or
death in the event of sudden braking
or a collision.
When using the seat belts, observe
the following:
Use the belt for only one person at
Keep the belts clean and dry. If
they need cleaning, use a mild soap
solution or lukewarm water. Never
use bleach, dye, or abrasive cleaners—they may severely weaken the
belts. (See ”Cleaning the interior”
in Part 5.)
Replace the belt assembly (including bolts) if it has been used in a
severe impact. The entire assembly
should be replaced even if damage
is not obvious.
a time. Do not use a single belt for
two or more people—even children.
Avoid reclining the seatbacks too
much. The seat belts provide maximum protection when the seatbacks
are in the upright position. (Refer
to the seat adjustment instructions.)
Be careful not to damage the belt
webbing or hardware. Take care that
they do not get caught or pinched
in the seat or doors.
Inspect the belt system periodically.
Check for cuts, fraying, and loose
parts. Damaged parts should be replaced. Do not disassemble or
modify the system.
33
’99camry U
—Front and rear seat belts
If the seat belt cannot be pulled out of the
retractor, firmly pull the belt and release
it. You will then be able to smoothly pull
the belt out of the retractor.
When a passenger’s shoulder belt is completely extended and is then retracted
even slightly, the belt is locked in that
position and cannot be extended. This feature is used to hold the child restraint
system securely. (For details, see ”Child
restraint” in this chapter.) To free the belt
again, fully retract the belt and then pull
the belt out once more.
Adjust the seat as needed (front seats
only) and sit up straight and well back
in the seat. To fasten your belt, pull it
out of the retractor and insert the tab
into the buckle.
CAUTION
Seat belts with an adjustable shoulder
anchor—
After inserting the tab, make sure
Adjust the shoulder anchor position to
your size.
You will hear a click when the tab locks
into the buckle.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in
The seat belt length automatically adjusts
to your size and the seat position.
The retractor will lock the belt during a
sudden stop or on impact. It also may
lock if you lean forward too quickly. A
slow, easy motion will allow the belt to
extend, and you can move around freely.
34
the tab and buckle are locked and
that the belt is not twisted.
the buckle as this may prevent you
from properly latching the tab and
buckle.
If the seat belt does not function
normally, immediately contact your
Toyota dealer. Do not use the seat
until the seat belt is fixed. It cannot
protect an adult occupant or your
child from injury.
To raise: Slide the anchor up.
To lower: Push in the lock release button
and slide the anchor down.
After adjustment make sure the anchor is
locked in position.
’99camry U
CAUTION
CAUTION
Take up
slack
Always make sure the shoulder belt
is positioned across the center of
your shoulder. The belt should be
kept away from your neck, but not
falling off your shoulder. Failure to
do so could reduce the amount of
protection in an accident and cause
serious injures in a collision.
Too high
lap
belts
and
loose–fitting belts both could cause
serious injuries due to sliding under the lap belt during a collision
or other unintended result. Keep
the lap belt positioned as low on
hips as possible.
For your safety, do not place the
Keep as low on
hips as possible
Adjust the position
shoulder belts.
High–positioned
shoulder belt under your arm.
of
the
Position the lap belt as low as
on your hips—not on your waist,
just it to a snug fit by pulling the
portion upward through the latch
lap and
possible
then adshoulder
plate.
35
’99camry U
—Seat belt extender
If your seat belt
curely because it
personalized seat
able from your
charge.
cannot be fastened seis not long enough, a
belt extender is availToyota dealer free of
Please contact your local Toyota dealer so
that the dealer can order the proper required length for the extender. Bring the
heaviest coat you expect to wear for proper measurement and selection of length.
Additional ordering information is available
at your Toyota dealer.
To release the belt, press the buckle–release button and allow the belt to retract.
If the belt does not retract smoothly, pull
it out and check for kinks or twists. Then
make sure it remains untwisted as it retracts.
CAUTION
When using the seat belt extender,
observe the following. Failure to follow these instructions could result in
less effectiveness of the seat belt restraint system in case of vehicle accident, increasing the chance of personal injury.
Never use the seat belt extender if
you can fasten the seat belt without
it.
36
Remember that the extender provided for you may not be safe when
used on a different vehicle, or for
another person or at a different
seating position than the one originally intended for.
’99camry U
—Front seat belt pretensioners
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure
the tab and buckle are locked and
that the seat belt extender is not
twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in
the buckle as this may prevent you
from properly latching the tab and
buckle.
If the seat belt does not function
To connect the extender to the seat
belt, insert the tab into the seat belt
buckle so that the ”PRESS” signs on
the buckle–release buttons of the extender and the seat belt are both facing
outward as shown.
You will hear a click when the tab locks
into the buckle.
When releasing the seat belt, press on
the buckle–release button on the extender,
not on the seat belt. This helps prevent
damage to the vehicle interior and extender itself.
normally, immediately contact your
Toyota dealer. Do not use the seat
until the seat belt is fixed. It cannot
protect an adult occupant or your
child from injury.
The driver and front passenger’s seat
belt pretensioners are designed to be
activated in response to a severe frontal impact.
When the airbag sensor detects the shock
of a severe frontal impact, the front seat
belt is quickly drawn back in by the retractor so that the belt snugly restrains
the front seat occupants.
The seat belt pretensioners are activated
even with no passenger in the front seat.
When not in use, remove the extender
and store in the vehicle for future use.
37
’99camry U
When a seat belt pretensioner is activated, an operating noise may be heard
and a small amount of smoke–like gas
may be released. This gas is harmless
and does not indicate that a fire is occurring.
Once the seat belt pretensioner has been
activated, the seat belt retractor remains
locked.
CAUTION
This indicator comes on when the ignition key is turned to the ”ACC” or
”ON” position. It goes off after about
6 seconds. This means the front seat
belt pretensioners are operating properly.
This warning light system monitors the
front airbag sensors, airbag sensor assembly, seat belt pretensioner assembly,
warning light, interconnecting wiring and
power sources. (For details, see ”Service
reminder indicators and warning buzzers”
in Chapter 1–5.)
38
The seat belt pretensioner system mainly
consists of the following components and
their locations are shown in the illustration.
1. Front airbag sensors
2. SRS airbag warning light
3. Seat belt pretensioner assemblies
4. Airbag sensor assembly
The seat belt pretensioner is controlled by
the airbag sensor assembly. The airbag
sensor assembly consists of a safing sensor and airbag sensor.
Do not modify, remove, strike or open
the front seat belt pretensioner assemblies, airbag sensor or surrounding area or wiring. Doing any of
these may cause sudden operation of
the front seat belt pretensioners or
disable the system, which could result in serious injury.
Failure to follow these instructions
can result in serious injuries.
’99camry U
If either front seat belt does not retract
NOTICE
or can not be pulled out due to a
malfunction or activation of the pretensioner.
Do not perform any of the following
changes without
consulting your
Toyota dealer. Such changes can
interfere with proper operation of the
seat belt pretensioners in some
cases.
The front seat belt pretensioner assembly or surrounding area has been damaged.
The front and side parts of the vehicle
Installation of electronic items such
as a mobile two–way radio, cassette
tape player or compact disc player
(shaded in the illustration) were involved in an accident that did not
cause the seat belt pretensioners to
operate.
Repairs on or near the front seat
belt retractor assemblies
Modification of the suspension system
The front seat belt pretensioner assem-
Attachment of a grille guard (bull
bar, kangaroo bar, etc.), snowplow,
winches or any other equipment to
the front end
This front seat belt pretensioner system
has a service reminder indicator to inform
the driver of operating problems. If either
of the following conditions occurs, this
indicates a malfunction of the airbags or
pretensioners. Contact your Toyota dealer
as soon as possible to service the
vehicle.
Repairs made on or near the front
fenders, front end structure or console
ignition key is turned to the ”ACC” or
”ON” position, or remains on.
Modification of the front end structure
bly is scratched, cracked, or otherwise
damaged.
The light does not come on when the
The light comes on or flashes while
driving.
39
’99camry U
SRS driver and front
passenger airbags
CAUTION
A driver or front passenger too close
to the steering wheel or dashboard
during airbag deployment can be
killed or seriously injured. Toyota
strongly recommends that:
The driver sit as far back as possible from the steering wheel while
still maintaining control of the vehicle.
The front passenger sit as far back
The SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) airbags are designed to provide
further protection for the driver and
front passenger when added to the primary protection provided by the seat
belts.
In response to a severe frontal impact,
the SRS airbags work together with the
seat belts to help prevent or reduce injury
by inflating, in order to decrease the likelihood of the driver’s or front passenger’s
head or chest directly hitting the steering
wheel or dashboard. The passenger airbag
is activated even with no passenger in the
front seat.
Be sure to wear your seat belt.
40
as possible from the dashboard.
All vehicle occupants be properly
restrained using the available seat
belts.
This indicator comes on when the ignition key is turned to the ”ACC” or
”ON” position. It goes off after about
6 seconds. This means the SRS airbags
are operating properly.
The SRS airbag warning light system
monitors the front airbag sensors, airbag
sensor assembly, inflators, warning light,
interconnecting wiring and power sources.
(For details, see ”Service reminder indicators and warning buzzers” in Chapter
1–5.)
’99camry U
If the severity of the impact is below the
above threshold level, the SRS airbags
may not deploy.
However, this threshold velocity will be
considerably higher if the vehicle strikes
an object, such as a parked vehicle or
sign pole, which can move or deform on
impact, or if it is involved in an underride
collision (e.g. a collision in which the nose
of the vehicle ”underrides”, or goes under,
the bed of a truck, etc.).
The SRS airbag system is designed to
activate in response to a severe frontal
impact within the shaded area between
the arrows in the illustration.
There may be the case that the SRS airbag will not activate with such an impact
in which the occupant wearing the seat
belt correctly would not get serious injury.
It is possible with collision severity at the
marginal level of airbag sensor detection
and activation that only one of your vehicle’s two airbags will deploy.
For the safety of all occupants, be sure
to always wear seat belts.
Collision from rear
Collision from the side
Vehicle rollover
The SRS airbags are not designed to
inflate if the vehicle is subjected to a
side or rear impact, if it rolls over, or
if it is involved in a low–speed frontal
collision.
The SRS airbags will deploy if the severity of the impact is above the designed
threshold level, comparable to an approximate 25 km/h (15 mph) collision when
impacting straight into a fixed barrier that
does not move or deform.
41
’99camry U
Hitting a curb,
edge of pavement
or hard material
In a severe frontal impact, sensors detect
deceleration and the system triggers the
airbag inflators. Then a chemical reaction
in the inflators momentarily fills the airbags with non–toxic gas to help restrain
the forward motion of the occupants.
Falling into or
jumping over a
deep hole
Landing hard or vehicle falling
The SRS airbags may deploy if a serious impact occurs to the underside of
your vehicle. Some examples are shown
in the illustration.
The SRS airbag system mainly consists of
the following components and their locations are shown in the illustration.
1. Front airbag sensors
2. SRS airbag warning light
3. Airbag module for passenger (airbag
and inflator)
4. Airbag sensor assembly
5. Airbag module for driver (airbag and
inflator)
The airbag sensor assembly consists of a
safing sensor and airbag sensor.
42
When the airbags inflate, they produce a
fairly loud noise and release some smoke
and residue along with non–toxic gas. This
does not indicate a fire. This gas is normally harmless, however, for those who
have delicate skin, it may cause minor
skin irritation. Be sure to wash off any
residue as soon as possible to prevent
minor skin irritation.
Deployment of the airbags happens in a
fraction of a second, so the airbags must
inflate with considerable force. While the
system is designed to reduce serious injuries, it may also cause minor burns or
abrasions and swellings.
Parts of the airbag module (steering wheel
hub, dashboard) may be hot for several
minutes, but the airbags themselves will
not be hot. The airbags are designed to
inflate only once.
’99camry U
A crash severe enough to inflate the airbags may break the windshield as the
vehicle buckles. In vehicles with a passenger airbag the windshield may also be
damaged by absorbing some of the force
of the inflating airbag.
CAUTION
The SRS airbag system is designed
only as a supplement to the primary protection of the driver side and
front passenger side seat belt systems. The front seat occupants can
be killed or seriously injured by an
inflating airbag if they do not wear
the available seat belts. During sudden braking just before a collision,
an unrestrained driver or front passenger can move forward into direct
contact with or close proximity to
the airbag which may then deploy
during the collision. To obtain maximum protection in an accident, the
driver and all passengers in the vehicle must wear their seat belts.
Wearing a seat belt during an accident reduces the chances of death
or serious injuries or being thrown
out of the vehicle. For instructions
and precautions concerning the seat
belt system, see ”Seat belts” in this
chapter.
Improperly seated and/or restrained
infants and children can be killed
or seriously injured by a deploying
airbag. An infant or child who is
too small to use a seat belt should
be properly secured using a child
restraint system. Toyota strongly
recommends that all infants and
children be placed in the rear seat
of the vehicle and properly restrained. The rear seat is the safest
for infants and children. For instructions concerning the installation of a child restraint system, see
”Child restraint” in this chapter.
43
’99camry U
For
instructions concerning the
installation of a child restraint system, see ”Child restraint” in this
chapter.
Move seat
fully back
Never put a rear–facing child re-
A forward–facing child restraint sys-
straint system on the front seat because the force of the rapid inflation of the passenger airbag can
cause death or serious injury to the
child.
tem should be allowed to put on
the front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as
far back as possible, because the
force of a deploying airbag could
cause death or serious injury to the
child. On vehicles with side airbags,
do not allow the child to lean
against the front door or around
the front door even if the child is
seated in the child restraint system.
It is dangerous if the side airbag
inflates, and the impact could cause
death or serious injury to the child.
44
’99camry U
Do not sit on the edge of the seat
Do not allow a child to stand up,
Do not put objects or your pets on
or lean over the dashboard when
the vehicle is in use. The airbags
inflate with considerable speed and
force; you may be killed or seriously injured. Sit up straight and well
back in the seat, and always use
your seat belt.
or to kneel on the front passenger
seat. The airbag inflates with considerable speed and force; the child
may be killed or seriously injured.
or in front of the dashboard or
steering wheel pad that houses the
airbag system. They might restrict
inflation or cause death or serious
injury as they are projected rearward by the force of deploying airbags. Likewise, the driver and front
passenger should not hold things in
their arms or on their knees.
Do not hold a child on your lap or
in your arms. Use a child restraint
system in the rear seat. For instructions concerning the installation of
a child restraint system, see ”Child
restraint” in this chapter.
45
’99camry U
Do not modify or remove any wiring. Do not modify, remove, strike
or open any components such as
the steering wheel column cover,
front passenger airbag cover, front
passenger airbag, airbag sensor assembly. Doing any of these may
cause sudden SRS airbag inflation
or disable the system, which could
result in death or serious injury.
Failure to follow these instructions
can result in death or serious injuries.
NOTICE
Do not perform any of the following
changes without
consulting your
Toyota dealer. Such changes can
interfere with proper operation of the
SRS airbag system in some cases.
Installation of electronic items such
as a mobile two–way radio, cassette
tape player or compact disc player
Modification of the suspension system
Modification of the front end structure
Attachment of a grille guard (bull
bar, kangaroo bar, etc.), snowplow,
winches or any other equipment to
the front end
Repairs made on or near the front
fenders, front end structure, console, steering column, steering
wheel or dashboard near the front
passenger airbag
46
This SRS airbag system has a service
reminder indicator to inform the driver of
operating problems. If either of the
following conditions occurs, this indicates
a malfunction of the airbags. Contact your
Toyota dealer as soon as possible to
service the vehicle.
The light does not come on when the
ignition key is turned to the ”ACC” or
”ON” position, or remains on.
The light comes on while driving.
’99camry U
SRS side airbags
NOTICE
Do not disconnect the battery cables
before contacting your Toyota dealer.
In the following cases, contact your Toyota
dealer as soon as possible:
The SRS airbags have been inflated.
The front part of the vehicle (shaded
in the illustration) were involved in an
accident that did not cause the SRS
airbags to inflate.
The pad section of the steering wheel
or
front passenger
airbag cover
(shaded in the illustration) is scratched,
cracked, or otherwise damaged.
The SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) side airbags are designed to provide further protection for the driver
and front passenger when added to the
primary protection provided by the seat
belts.
In response to a severe side impact, the
SRS side airbags work together with the
seat belt to help prevent or reduce injury
by inflating, in order to decrease the impact mainly on the driver’s or front passenger’s chest. The SRS side airbag on
the passenger seat is activated even with
no passenger in the front seat.
Be sure to wear your seat belt.
47
’99camry U
CAUTION
SRS side airbags inflate with considerable force. To avoid potential death
or serious injury during inflation of a
side airbag, Toyota strongly recommends that the driver and front passenger;
Wear their seat belt
Remain properly seated with their
back against the seat at all times.
This indicator comes on when the ignition key is turned to the ”ACC” or
”ON” position. It goes off after about
6 seconds. This means the SRS side
airbags are operating properly.
The warning light system monitors the airbag sensor assembly, inflators, warning
light, interconnecting wiring and power
sources. (For details, see ”Service reminder indicators and warning buzzers” in
Chapter 1–5.)
48
The SRS side airbags may not inflate if
the vehicle is subjected to a collision
from the side at an angle, or a collision
to the side of the vehicle body other
than the passenger compartment shown
in the illustration, which impact is not
severe enough for the passenger
compartment.
’99camry U
There may be the case that the SRS side
airbags will not activate with such an impact in which the occupant wearing the
seat belt correctly would not get serious
injury.
Collision from the rear
The SRS side airbags are designed to
inflate when the passenger compartment
gets a severe impact from the side.
For the safety of all occupants, be sure
to always wear seat belts.
Collision from the front
Vehicle rollover
The SRS side airbags are not designed
to inflate if the vehicle is subjected to
a front or rear impact, if it rolls over,
or if it is involved in a low–speed side
collision.
The SRS side airbag system mainly consists of the following components and
their locations are shown in the illustration.
1. SRS airbag warning light
2. Side airbag modules
(airbag and inflator)
3. Side airbag sensor assemblies
4. Airbag sensor assembly
The SRS side airbag system is controlled
by the airbag sensor assembly. The airbag
sensor assembly consists of a safing sensor and airbag sensor.
49
’99camry U
In a severe side impact, the side airbag
sensor triggers the side airbag inflators.
Then a chemical reaction in the inflators
momentarily fills the airbags with non–toxic gas to help restrain the lateral motion
of the occupants.
When the airbags inflate, they produce a
fairly loud noise and release some smoke
and residue along with non–toxic gas. This
does not indicate a fire. This gas is normally harmless, however, for those who
have delicate skin, it may cause minor
skin irritation. Be sure to wash off any
residue as soon as possible to prevent
minor skin irritation.
Deployment of the airbags happen in a
fraction of a second, so the airbags must
inflate with considerable force. While the
system is designed to reduce serious injuries, it may also cause minor burns or
abrasions and swellings.
Front seats may be hot for several minutes, but the airbags themselves will not
be hot. The airbags are designed to inflate
only once.
50
CAUTION
The SRS side airbag system is designed only as a supplement to the
primary protection of the driver
side and front passenger side seat
belt systems. The front seat occupants can be killed or seriously injured by an inflating airbag if they
do not wear the available seat
belts. During sudden braking just
before a collision, an unrestrained
driver or front passenger can move
sideward into direct contact with or
close proximity to the airbag which
may then deploy during the collision. To obtain maximum protection
in an accident, the driver and all
passengers in the vehicle must
wear their seat belts. Wearing a
seat belt during an accident reduces the chances of death or serious injuries or being thrown out of
the vehicle. For instructions and
precautions concerning the seat
belt system, see ”Seat belts” in this
chapter.
Improperly seated and/or restrained
infants and children can be killed
or seriously injured by a deploying
airbag. An infant or child who is
too small to use a seat belt should
be properly secured using a child
restraint system. Toyota strongly
recommends that all infants and
children be placed in the rear seat
of the vehicle and properly restrained. The rear seat is the safest
for infants and children. For instructions concerning the installation of a child restraint system, see
”Child restraint” in this chapter.
Do not allow the child to lean
against the front door or around
the front door even if the child is
seated in the child restraint system.
It is dangerous if the side airbag
inflates and the impact could cause
death or serious injury to the child.
For
instructors concerning
the
installation of a child restraint system, see ”Child restraint” in this
chapter.
’99camry U
Do not use accessories for the
seats which cover the parts where
the side airbags should inflate.
Such accessories may prevent the
side airbags from activating correctly, causing death or serious injury.
Do not modify or replace the seats
or surface of the front seats with
the side airbags. Such changes may
disable the system or cause the
side airbags to inflate, resulting in
death or serious injury. Consult
your Toyota dealer.
Do not lean against the front door
Do not attach a cup holder or any
when the vehicle is in use. The side
airbag inflates with considerable
speed and force; you may be killed
or seriously injured.
other device on or around the door.
When the side airbag inflates, the
cup holder or any other device will
be thrown with great force or the
side airbag may not activate correctly, resulting in death or serious
injury. Likewise, the driver and front
passenger should not hold things in
their arms or on their knees.
Do not apply excessive weight to
the outer side of the front seats on
vehicles with side airbags.
The child
head should not be
leaned against the vicinity of the
part where the side airbag activates.
Failure to follow these instructions
can result in death or serious injuries.
51
’99camry U
NOTICE
Do not perform any of the following
changes without
consulting your
Toyota dealer. Such changes can
interfere with proper operation of the
SRS airbag system in some cases.
Installation of electronic items such
as a mobile two–way radio, cassette
tape player or compact disc player
Modification of the suspension system
Modification of the side structure of
the passenger compartment
Repairs made on or near the console or front seat
This SRS side airbag system has a
service reminder indicator to inform the
driver of operating problems. If either of
the following conditions occurs, this
indicates a malfunction of the airbags.
Contact your Toyota dealer as soon as
possible to service the vehicle.
The light does not come on when the
ignition key is turned to the ”ACC” or
”ON” position, or remains on.
The light comes on or flashes while
driving.
52
In the following cases, contact your Toyota
dealer as soon as possible:
The SRS side airbags have been inflated.
The portion of the doors (shaded in the
illustration) were involved in an accident that did not cause the SRS side
airbags to inflate.
The surface of the seats with the side
airbag (shaded in the illustration) is
scratched, cracked, or otherwise damaged.
’99camry U
Child restraint—
—Child restraint precautions
NOTICE
Do not disconnect the battery cables
before contacting your Toyota dealer.
Toyota strongly urges the use of child
restraint systems for children small
enough to use them.
The laws of all fifty states in the U.S.A.
and Canada now require the use of a
child restraint system.
Your vehicle conforms to SAEJ1819.
If a child is too large for a child restraint
system, the child should sit in the rear
seat and must be restrained using the
vehicle’s seat belt. See ”Seat belts” for
details.
CAUTION
For effective protection in automobile accidents and sudden stops,
children must be properly restrained using a seat belt or child
restraint system depending on the
age and size of the child. Holding
a child in your arms is not a substitute for a child restraint system.
In an accident, the child can be
crushed against the windshield, or
between you and the vehicle’s interior.
Toyota strongly urges use of a
proper child restraint system which
conforms to the size of the child,
and is put on the rear seat. According to accident statistics, the child
is safer when properly restrained in
the rear seat than in the front seat.
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat. In
the event of an accident, the force
of the rapid inflation of the airbag
can cause death or serious injury if
a rear–facing child restraint system
is put on the front seat.
Unless it is unavoidable, do not put
a child restraint
front seat.
system
on
the
53
’99camry U
—Child restraint system
A forward–facing child restraint system should be allowed to put on
the front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as
far back as possible, because the
force of a deploying airbag could
cause death or serious injury to the
child. Do not allow the child to lean
against the front door or around
the front door even if the child is
seated in the child restraint system.
It is dangerous if the side airbag
inflates, and the impact could cause
death or serious injury to the child.
Make sure that you have complied
with all installation instructions provided
by
the
child
restraint
manufacturer and that the system is
properly secured.
54
A child restraint system for a small
child or baby must itself be properly
restrained on the seat with the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt. You must
carefully consult the manufacturer’s instructions which accompany your child
restraint system.
To provide proper restraint, use a child
restraint system following the manufacturer’s instructions about the appropriate age
and size of the child for the restraint system.
Install the child restraint system correctly
following the instructions provided by its
manufacturer of the system. General directions are also provided under the following illustrations.
The child restraint system should be
installed on the rear seat. According to
accident statistics, the child is safer when
properly restrained in the rear seat than
in the front seat.
CAUTION
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat. In
the event of an accident, the force
of the rapid inflation of the airbag
can cause death or serious injury if
a rear–facing child restraint system
is put on the front seat.
Unless it is unavoidable, do not put
a child restraint
front seat.
system
on
the
A forward–facing child restraint system should be allowed to put on
the front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as
far back as possible, because the
force of a deploying airbag could
cause death or serious injury to the
child. Do not allow the child to lean
against the front door or around
the front door even if the child is
seated in the child restraint system.
It is dangerous if the side airbag
inflates, and the impact could cause
death or serious injury to the child.
’99camry U
After installing the child restraint
system, make sure it is secured in
place following the manufacturer’s
instructions. If it is not restrained
securely, it may cause death or serious injury to the child in the
event of a sudden stop or accident.
When not using the child restraint system,
keep it secured with the seat belt or place
it in the trunk or somewhere other than
the passenger compartment. This will prevent it from injuring passengers in the
event of a sudden stop or accident.
For instructions about how to install the
anchor bracket, see ”Top strap anchors
and locations”.
If your child restraint system does not
provide any of the necessary parts, you
can purchase the following items from
your Toyota dealer.
CRS installation kit
(Part No. 04731–22012)—contains 1
bolt, 3 types of spacers and 1 locking clip.
Bolt (Part No. 91511–60830)
Your vehicle has anchors for securing the
top strap of a child restraint system. The
anchor nuts are welded beneath the sheet
metal to permit installation of an anchor
bracket for a child restraint system.
To install an anchor bracket, use an 8 mm
30 mm 1.25 mm coarse thread metric bolt and 15 mm (0.6 in.) spacer. Note
that the bolts accompanying many child
restraint systems are not metric. You can
damage the anchor nuts on your vehicle
if you force bolts with different thread into
the anchor nuts.
55
’99camry U
—Built–in child restraint
The built–in child restraint system mainly
consists of a child seat integrated in the
rear seat and 5–point seat belts. Refer to
the illustration to become familiar with the
parts of the system. This child restraint
system conforms to U.S. Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No.213 and Canada Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No.213.4.
1. Shoulder belts
2. Head restraint lock release button
3. Storage bag (for the head restraint and
upper pad)
4. Head restraint and upper pad
(for the rear seat)
5. Maximum shoulder height indicator
label
6. Removable pad
7. Seat belt buckle
8. Seat belt release strap (black)
9. Seat belt adjustment strap (gray tab)
10. Child seat cushion
11. Seat belt buckle release button
12. Seat belt tabs
13. Owner’s manual supplement
14. Shoulder belt clip
56
’99camry U
This child restraint is designed for use
only by children who weigh between 10
and 30 kg (22.1 and 66.1 pounds), and
whose height is between 85 and 127 cm
(33.5 and 50.0 inches).
The child should be at least one year
old and must be capable of sitting upright alone and whose shoulder height
is at or below the maximum shoulder
height indicator.
It is important to use a rear–facing
child restraint until the child is about
a year old. A rear–facing restraint gives
the child’s head, neck and body the
support they would need in a crash.
See ”—Child restraint system” for more
information.
If your child’s shoulders are above the
indicator position, do not use the built–
in child restraint. Your child should use
the vehicle’s seat belts.
According to accident statistics, children
are safer when properly restrained in the
rear seat than in the front seat.
Keep the belts clean and dry. If
CAUTION
Make sure the child is securely restrained with the built–in child restraint. WARNING! Failure to follow
the manufacturer’s instructions on the
use of this child restraint system can
result in your child striking the vehicle’s interior during a sudden stop
or crash. Snugly adjust the belts provided with this child restraint around
your child.
When using the built–in child
straint, observe the following:
re-
Use the belts for only one child at
a time. Do not use the belts for two
or more children.
Be careful not to damage the belt
webbing or hardware. Take care that
they do not get caught or pinched
in the seatback.
they need cleaning, use a mild soap
solution or lukewarm water. Never
use bleach, dye, or abrasive cleaners—they may severely weaken the
belts.
Replace the built–in child restraint
assembly if it has been used in a
severe impact. The entire assembly
should be replaced even if damage
is not obvious.
Do not use a separate child restraint system over the
built–in child restraint.
opened
When the built–in child restraint is
in use, do not use the adult lap and
shoulder belt instead of the built–in
child restraint seat belt as it can
cause severe injury to the child in
a sudden stop or crash.
Inspect the belt system periodically.
Check for cuts, fraying, and loose
parts. Damaged parts should be replaced. Do not disassemble or
modify the child restraint belt system.
57
’99camry U
1. Remove the head restraint and upper
pad by pressing the head restraint
lock release button and pulling up
the head restraint and upper pad.
Lower the child seat cushion.
2. Insert the head restraint and upper
pad into the storage bag. Then place
the storage bag into the trunk by
attaching with Velcro.
CAUTION
Do not use the built–in child restraint
with the head restraint and upper pad
installed. When using the built–in
child restraint, the head restraint and
upper pad should be stored in the
trunk.
58
3. While pulling the seat belt release
strap (black), pull both shoulder
belts together.
Pull the seat belt release strap from
above at about 45 angle to the child seat
cushion.
If the shoulder belts cannot be pulled out,
return the child seat cushion to an almost
closed position, firmly pull the seat belt
release strap and at the same time pull
both shoulder belts, then lower the child
seat cushion again.
’99camry U
4. Compress the shoulder belt clip to
separate the right and left shoulder
belts.
5. Pull down the seatback part of the
removable pad. Make sure the child’s
shoulders are at or below the maximum shoulder height indicator label.
6. Press the removable pad against the
fastener tapes and install the pad to
the seatback. Make sure the belts go
through the slots in the pad.
The removable pad is attached by fastener tapes.
CAUTION
CAUTION
If your child’s shoulders are above
the maximum shoulder height indicator label, do not use the built–in child
restraint. Your child should use the
adult lap and shoulder belt.
If you have removed the removable
pad for cleaning etc., do not use the
built–in child restraint without the
pad.
59
’99camry U
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in
the buckle as this may prevent you
from properly latching the tabs and
buckle.
If the seat belt does not function
normally, it cannot protect your
child from injury. Contact your Toyota dealer immediately. Do not use
the built–in child restraint until the
seat belt is fixed.
7. Sit the child on the child seat. Place
a shoulder belt over each shoulder.
Insert the tabs into the buckle.
CAUTION
When the built–in child restraint is
in use, do not use the adult lap and
shoulder belt instead of the built–in
child restraint seat belt as it can
cause severe injury to the child in
a sudden stop or crash.
After inserting the tabs, make sure
the tabs and buckle are locked and
that the shoulder belts and buckle
strap are not twisted.
60
8. Fasten the shoulder belt clip.
The purpose of the clip is to keep the
shoulder belts positioned correctly on the
shoulders.
CAUTION
An unfastened shoulder belt clip will
not help keep the belts on the child’s
shoulders. In a sudden stop or crash,
the child may go too far forward and
be seriously injured. Make sure the
belt clip is fastened at all times.
’99camry U
9. Pull the seat belt adjustment strap
(gray tab) firmly until the shoulder
belts are snugly adjusted around the
child’s shoulders.
You should not be able to put more than
two fingers between a shoulder belt and
the child’s chest.
After adjusting the shoulder belt tightness,
move the shoulder belt clip 5 to 8 cm (2
to 3 in.) below the child’s chin. On each
belt, the shoulder part should be centered
on the child’s shoulder. The belts should
be away from the child’s face and neck,
but not falling off the child’s shoulders.
10. To release the child from the seat
belts, separate the shoulder belts
then press the buckle release button.
Move both belts off the child’s shoulders.
11. To store the built–in child restraint,
fasten the shoulder belt clip and return the seat belt buckle using the
fastener tapes. Fold up the seat belt
adjustment strap (gray tab) in the
seat so that the edge of the strap
does not come out the raised child
restraint seat cushion. Raise the
child restratraint seat cushion and
reinstall the head restraint and upper
pad correctly by inserting the posts
into the holes.
61
’99camry U
—Types of child restraint system
CAUTION
Before using the vehicle’s seat belt,
make sure the head restraint and upper pad is reinstalled. Do not occupy
this position unless the head restraint
and upper pad is reinstalled as serious injury may result.
Child restraint systems are classified into
the following 3 types depending on the
child’s age and size.
(A) Infant seat
(B) Convertible seat
(C) Booster seat
Install the child restraint system following
the instructions provided by its manufacturer.
(A) Infant seat
(B) Convertible seat
62
’99camry U
—Installation with 3–point
type seat belt
(C) Booster seat
(A) INFANT SEAT INSTALLATION
An infant seat is used in rear–facing
position only.
CAUTION
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat because the force of the rapid inflation of the passenger airbag can
cause death or serious injury to the
child.
63
’99camry U
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure
the tab and buckle are locked and
that the lap and shoulder portions
of the belt are not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in
the buckle as this may prevent you
from properly latching the tab and
buckle.
If the seat belt does not function
Do not put a rear–facing child restraint system on the rear seat if it
interferes with the lock mechanism
of the front seats. This can cause
severe injury to the child and front
passenger in case of sudden braking or a collision.
64
1. Run the lap and shoulder belt through
or around the infant seat following the
instructions provided by its manufacturer and insert the tab into the buckle
taking care not to twist the belt. Keep
the lap portion of the belt tight.
normally, it cannot protect your
child from injury. Contact your
Toyota dealer immediately. Do not
use the seat until the seat belt is
fixed.
’99camry U
2. Fully extend the shoulder belt to put it
in the lock mode. When the belt is
then retracted even slightly, it cannot
be extended.
To hold the infant seat securely, make
sure the belt is in the lock mode before
letting the belt retract.
3. While pressing
against the seat
let the shoulder
it will go to hold
ly.
the infant seat firmly
cushion and seatback,
belt retract as far as
the infant seat secure-
CAUTION
Push and pull the child restraint system in different directions to be sure
it is secure. Follow all the installation
instructions provided by its manufacturer.
65
’99camry U
4. To remove the infant seat, press the
buckle–release button and allow the
belt to retract completely. The belt will
move freely again and be ready to
work for an adult or older child passenger.
66
(B) CONVERTIBLE SEAT INSTALLATION
A convertible seat is used in forward–
facing and rear–facing position depending on the child’s age and size. When
installing, follow the manufacturer’s instructions about the applicable child’s
age and size as well as directions for
installing a child restraint system.
CAUTION
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat because the force of the rapid inflation of the passenger airbag can
cause death or serious injury to the
child.
’99camry U
Move seat
fully back
A forward–facing child restraint sys-
Do not put a rear–facing child re-
tem should be allowed to put on
the front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as
far back as possible, because the
force of a deploying airbag could
cause death or serious injury to the
child. Do not allow the child to lean
against the front door or around
the front door even if the child is
seated in the child restraint system.
It is dangerous if the side airbag
inflates, and the impact could cause
death or serious injury to the child.
straint system on the rear seat if it
interferes with the lock mechanism
of the front seats. This can cause
severe injury to the child and front
passenger in case of sudden braking or a collision.
1. Run the lap and shoulder belt through
or around the convertible seat following
the
instructions
provided
by
its
manufacturer and insert the tab into
the buckle taking care not to twist the
belt. Keep the lap portion of the belt
tight.
67
’99camry U
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure
the tab and buckle are locked and
that the lap and shoulder portions
of the belt are not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in
the buckle as this may prevent you
from properly latching the tab and
buckle.
If the seat belt does not function
normally, it cannot protect your
child from injury. Contact your
Toyota dealer immediately. Do not
use the seat until the seat belt is
fixed.
2. Fully extend the shoulder belt to put it
in the lock mode. When the belt is
then retracted even slightly, it cannot
be extended.
To hold the convertible seat securely,
make sure the belt is in the lock mode
before letting the belt retract.
68
3. While pressing the convertible seat
firmly against the seat cushion and
seatback, let the shoulder belt retract
as far as it will go to hold the convertible seat securely.
’99camry U
CAUTION
Push and pull the child restraint system in different directions to be sure
it is secure. Follow all the installation
instructions provided by its manufacturer.
4. To remove the convertible seat, press
the buckle–release button and allow the
belt to retract completely. The belt will
move freely again and be ready to
work for an adult or older child passenger.
(C) BOOSTER SEAT INSTALLATION
A booster seat is used in forward–facing position only.
69
’99camry U
CAUTION
Always make sure the shoulder belt
is positioned across the center of
child’s shoulder. The belt should be
kept away from child’s neck, but
not falling off child’s shoulder. Failure to do so could reduce the
amount of protection in an accident
and cause serious injuries in a collision.
High–positioned
Move seat fully back
CAUTION
A forward–facing child restraint system should be allowed to put on the
front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as far
back as possible, because the force
of a deploying airbag could cause
death or serious injury to the child.
Do not allow the child to lean against
the front door or around the front
door even if the child is seated in the
child restraint system. It is dangerous
if the side airbag inflates, and the
impact could cause death or serious
injury to the child.
70
1. Sit the child on a booster seat. Run
the lap and shoulder belt through or
around the booster seat and child following the instructions provided by its
manufacturer and insert the tab into
the buckle taking care not to twist the
belt.
Make sure the shoulder belt is correctly
across the child’s shoulder and that the
lap belt is positioned as low as possible
on child’s hips. See ”Seat belts” for details.
lap
belts
and
loose–fitting belts both could cause
serious injuries due to sliding under the lap belt during a collision
or other unintended result. Keep
the lap belt positioned as low on
hips as possible.
For child’s safety, do not place the
shoulder belt under child’s arm.
After inserting the tab, make sure
the tab and buckle are locked and
that the lap and shoulder portions
of the belt are not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in
the buckle as this may prevent you
from properly latching the tab and
buckle.
’99camry U
—Top strap anchors and
locations
If the seat belt does not function
normally, it cannot protect your
child from injury. Contact your
Toyota dealer immediately. Do not
use the seat until the seat belt is
fixed.
2. To remove the child restraint system,
press the buckle–release button and allow the belt to retract.
If your child restraint system requires
the use of a top strap, latch the hook
onto the anchor bracket and tighten the
top strap.
See the following instructions to install the
anchor bracket.
71
’99camry U
Bolt
Anchor bracket
Anchor
bracket
Bolt
Bolt
Anchor bracket
345 mm
(13.6 in.)
Spacer
Spacer
Spacer
100 mm
(4.0 in.)
100 mm
(4.0 in.)
185 mm
(7.3 in.)
TYPE A
Outside anchors—
TYPE B
On the filler panel behind the rear seat
a. Remove the cap as shown in the illustration.
On the filler panel behind the rear seat
b. Insert a 15 mm (0.6 in.) spacer and
tighten down the anchor bracket for
your child restraint system with a bolt.
Torque the bolt to 16.5—24.7 N⋅m
(1.68—2.52 kgf⋅m, 12.2—18.2 ft⋅lbf).
a. Using the illustration as a guide, run
your fingers across the trim of the filler
panel itself to locate the position of the
holes underneath.
Center anchor—
a. Using the illustration as a guide, run
your fingers across the trim of the filler
panel itself to locate the position of the
holes underneath.
b. Make a hole in the covering directly
above the hole in the filler panel.
c. Insert a 15 mm (0.6 in.) spacer and
tighten down the anchor bracket for
your child restraint system with a bolt.
Torque the bolt to 16.5—24.7 N⋅m
(1.68—2.52 kgf⋅m, 12.2—18.2 ft⋅lbf).
72
Center anchor—
b. Make a hole in the covering directly
above the hole in the filler panel.
c. Insert a 15 mm (0.6 in.) spacer and
tighten down the anchor bracket for your
child restraint system with a bolt. Torque
the bolt to 16.5—24.7 N⋅m (1.68—2.52
kgf⋅m, 12.2—18.2 ft⋅lbf).
’99camry U
Tilt steering wheel
To comply with Canadian Motor Vehicle
Safety Standards, this model sold in Canada is provided with a bracket set in the
glovebox, designed for use with any of the
3 anchor locations shown in the illustration.
If your child restraint system does not
provide any of the necessary parts, ask
your Toyota dealer. (See ”—Child restraint
system”.)
Outside anchors—
a. Should you select to use the outer
anchor positions, please contact your
Toyota dealer for proper modifications to
the filler panel.
b. After modifications have been made to
the filler panel, insert a 15 mm (0.6 in.)
spacer and tighten down the anchor bracket for your child restraint system with a
bolt. Torque the bolt to 16.5—24.7 N⋅m
(1.68—2.52 kgf⋅m, 12.2—18.2 ft⋅lbf).
To change the steering wheel angle,
hold the steering wheel, pull up the
lock release lever, tilt the steering
wheel to the desired angle and release
the lever.
When the steering wheel is in a low position, it will spring up as you release the
lock release lever.
c. Securely latch the hook of the top strap
onto the anchor bracket and make sure
the hook does not make contact with the
filler panel.
73
’99camry U
Outside rear view mirrors—
CAUTION
CAUTION
Do not adjust the steering wheel
Do not adjust the mirror while the
while the vehicle is moving.
vehicle is moving. It may cause the
driver to mishandle the vehicle and
an accident may occur resulting in
personal injuries.
After adjusting the steering wheel,
try moving it up and down to make
sure it is locked in position.
Since the mirror surfaces can get
hot, keep your hands off them when
the defogger switch is on.
Adjust the mirror so that you can just
see the side of your vehicle in the mirror.
Be careful when judging the size or distance of any object seen in the outside
rear view mirror on the passenger’s side.
It is a convex mirror with a curved surface. Any object seen in a convex mirror
will look smaller and farther away than
when seen in a flat mirror.
On some models, when you push the rear
window defogger switch, the heater panels
in the outside rear view mirrors will quickly clear the mirror surface.
74
’99camry U
—Rear view mirror remote
control
—Power rear view mirror
control
NOTICE
If ice should jam the mirror, do not
operate the control or scrape the mirror face. Use a spray de–icer to free
the mirror.
To adjust the rear view mirror, simply
operate the control lever.
NOTICE
If ice should jam the mirror, do not
operate the control or scrape the mirror face. Use a spray de–icer to free
the mirror.
To adjust a mirror, use the switches.
1. Master switch—To select the mirror to
be adjusted
Place the switch at ”L” (left) or ”R”
(right).
2. Control switch—To move the mirror Push the switch in the desired
direction.
Mirror can be adjusted when key is in the
”ACC” or ”ON” position.
75
’99camry U
Anti–glare inside rear view
mirror
Sun visors—
CAUTION
Do not adjust the mirror while the
vehicle is moving. It may cause the
driver to mishandle the vehicle and
an accident may occur resulting in
personal injuries.
Adjust the mirror so that you can just
see the rear of your vehicle in the mirror.
To block out glare, move the sun visor.
To reduce glare from the headlights of
the vehicle behind you during night
driving, operate the lever on the lower
edge of the mirror.
To block out glare from the side—Swing
down the sun visor, remove it from the
hook and swing it to the lateral side (position 2).
Daylight driving—Lever at position 1
If glare comes from obliquely behind you,
extend the plate at the end of the visor
(to position 3 or 4).
The reflection in the mirror has greater
clarity at this position.
Night driving—Lever at position 2
Remember that by reducing glare you also
lose some rear view clarity.
76
To block out glare from the front—Swing
down the sun visor (position 1).
’99camry U
—Vanity mirrors
CAUTION
Do not extend the plate at the end of
the sun visor when the visor is in the
position 1. It can cover the anti–glare
inside rear view mirror and obstruct
the rear view.
To use the vanity mirrors, swing down
the sun visor and open the cover.
On some models, the vanity light comes
on when you open the cover.
77
’99camry U
78
’99camry U
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Headlights and turn signals
NOTICE
To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not leave the lights on
for a long period when the engine is
not running.
Chapter 1–4
Lights, Wipers and
Defogger
Daytime running light system
The headlights turn on at reduced intensity when the parking brake is released with
the engine started, even with the light
switch in the ”OFF” position. They will not
go off until the ignition switch is turned
off.
Headlights and turn signals
Emergency flashers
Instrument panel light control
Interior light
Ignition switch light
Personal light
Windshield wipers and washer
Rear window and outside
rear view mirror defoggers
HEADLIGHTS
To turn on the following lights: Twist
the headlight/turn signal lever knob.
Position 1—Parking, tail, license plate,
side marker and instrument panel lights
Position
above
2—Headlights
and
all
of
the
The lights automatically turn off when the
driver’s door is opened with the ignition
turned off. To turn them on again, turn the
key to the ”ON” position or actuate the
headlight switch. If you are going to park
for over one week, make sure the headlight switch is off.
To turn on the other exterior lights and
instrument panel lights, twist the knob to
the position 1.
Twist the knob to the position 2 to turn
the headlights to full intensity for driving
at night.
The headlights automatically turn to full
intensity in the twilight even with the light
switch in the ”OFF” position.
79
’99camry U
The daytime running light control sensor
is on the top of the passenger’s side
instrument panel.
Do not place anything on the instrument
panel, and/or do not affix anything on the
windshield to block this sensor.
High–Low beams—For high beams, turn
the headlights on and push the lever away
from you (position 1). Pull the lever toward you (position 2) for low beams.
TURN SIGNALS
The headlight high beam indicator light
(blue light) on the instrument panel will
tell you that the high beams are on.
The key must be in the ”ON” position.
Flashing the high
(position 3)—Pull the
back. The high beam
when you release the
beam headlights
lever all the way
headlights turn off
lever.
You can flash the high beam headlights
with the knob turned to ”OFF”.
80
To signal a turn, push the headlight/
turn signal lever up or down to position
1.
The lever automatically returns after you
make a turn, but you may have to return
it by hand after you change lanes.
To signal a lane change, move the lever
up or down to the pressure point (position
2) and hold it.
If the turn signal indicator lights (green
lights) on the instrument panel flash faster
than normal, a front or rear turn signal
bulb is burned out.
’99camry U
Emergency flashers
Instrument panel light control
NOTICE
To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not leave the switch on
longer than necessary when the engine is not running.
To turn on the
push the switch.
emergency
flashers,
To adjust the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the knob.
All the turn signal lights will flash. To turn
them off, push the switch once again.
Turn on the emergency flashers to warn
other drivers if your vehicle must be
stopped where it might be a traffic hazard.
Always pull as far off the road as possible.
The turn signal light switch will not work
when the emergency flashers are operating.
81
’99camry U
Interior light
Ignition switch light
Personal light
To turn on the interior light, slide the
switch.
For easy access to the ignition switch,
the ignition switch light comes on when
any of the doors are opened.
To turn on the personal light, push the
switch. To turn it off, push the switch
once again.
The interior light switch has the following
positions:
”ON”—Keeps the light on all the time.
”OFF”—Turns the light off.
”DOOR”—Turns the light on when any of
the door is opened. The light goes off
when all the doors are closed. On some
models, the light remains on for some
time after all of the doors are closed.
82
The light remains on for a certain time
after all the doors are closed.
Vehicles with power door lock system
—When all the doors are locked or the
ignition switch is turned to ”ACC”, ”ON”
after all the doors are closed, the light
fades out.
’99camry U
Windshield wipers and
washer
Rear window and outside
rear view mirror defoggers
To squirt washer fluid, pull the lever
toward you.
If the windshield wipers are off, they will
operate a couple of times after the washer
squirts.
For instructions on adding washer fluid,
see ”Adding washer fluid” in Chapter 7–3.
In freezing weather, warm the windshield
with the defroster before using the washer.
This will help prevent the washer fluid
from freezing on your windshield, which
can block your vision.
To turn on the windshield wipers, move
the lever to the desired setting.
The key must be in the ”ON” position.
Lever position
Speed setting
Position 1
Intermittent
Position 2
Slow
Position 3
Fast
With interval adjuster: The ”INT TIME”
band lets you adjust the wiping time interval when the wiper lever is in the intermittent position (position 1). Twist the band
upward to increase the time between
sweeps, and downward to decrease it.
NOTICE
Do not operate the wipers if the windshield is dry. It may scratch the
glass.
To defog or defrost the rear window,
push the switch.
The key must be in the ”ON” position.
The thin heater wires on the inside of the
rear window will quickly clear the surfaces. An indicator light will illuminate to
indicate the defogger is operating.
On some models, heater panels in the
outside rear view mirrors will also quickly
clear the surfaces.
Push the switch once again to turn the
defogger off.
The system will automatically shut off after the defogger has operated about 15
minutes.
83
’99camry U
CAUTION
Since the mirror surfaces can get hot
keep your hands off them when the
defogger switch is on.
Make sure you turn the defoggers off
when the surfaces are clear. Leaving the
defoggers on for a long time could cause
the battery to discharge, especially during
stop–and–go driving. The defoggers are
not designed for drying rain water or for
melting snow.
If the outside rear view mirrors are heavily coated with ice, use a spray de–icer
before operating the switch.
NOTICE
When cleaning the inside of the rear
window, be careful not to scratch or
damage the heater wires.
84
’99camry U
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–5
Gauges, Meters and
Service reminder
indicators
Fuel gauge
Engine coolant temperature
gauge
Tachometer
Odometer and two trip meters
Service reminder indicators and
warning buzzers
Fuel gauge
On inclines or curves, due to the movement of fuel in the tank, the fuel gauge
needle may fluctuate or the low fuel level
warning light may come on earlier than
usual.
If the fuel tank is completely empty, the
malfunction indicator lamp comes on. Fill
the fuel tank immediately.
Low fuel level
warning light
The indicator lamp goes off after driving
several times. If the indicator lamp does
not go off, contact your Toyota dealer as
soon as possible.
The gauge works when the ignition
switch is on and indicates the approximate quantity of fuel remaining in the
tank.
Nearly full—Needle at ”F”
Nearly empty—Needle at ”E”
It is a good idea to keep the tank over
1/4 full.
This fuel gauge has a non–return type
needle which remains at the last indicated
position when the ignition switch is turned
off.
If the fuel level approaches ”E” or the low
fuel level warning light comes on, fill the
fuel tank as soon as possible.
85
’99camry U
Engine coolant temperature
gauge
Tachometer
Idling for a long period with the air
conditioning on in stop–and–go traffic.
Towing a trailer.
NOTICE
Do not remove the thermostat in
the engine cooling system as this
may cause the engine to overheat.
The thermostat is designed to control the flow of coolant to keep the
temperature of the engine within
the specified operating range.
The gauge indicates the engine coolant
temperature when the ignition switch is
on. The engine operating temperature
will vary with changes in weather and
engine load.
If the needle moves into the red zone,
your engine is too hot. If your vehicle
overheats, stop your vehicle and allow the
engine to cool.
Your vehicle may overheat during severe
operating conditions, such as:
Driving up a long hill on a hot day.
Reducing speed or stopping after high
speed driving.
86
Do not continue driving with an
overheated engine. See ”If your vehicle overheats” in Part 4.
The tachometer indicates engine speed
in thousands of rpm (revolutions per
minute). Use it while driving to select
correct shift points and to prevent engine lugging and overrevving.
Driving with the engine running too fast
causes excessive engine wear and poor
fuel economy. Remember, in most cases
the slower the engine speed, the greater
the fuel economy.
NOTICE
Do not let the indicator needle get
into the red zone. This may cause
severe engine damage.
’99camry U
Service reminder indicators
and warning buzzers
Odometer and two trip meters
3. Trip meter reset knob—It can reset the
two trip meters to zero, and also
change the meter display.
To change the meter display, quickly
push and release the knob. The meter
display changes in the order from the
odometer to trip meter A to trip meter
B, then back to the odometer each
time you push.
This meter displays the odometer and
two trip meters.
1. Odometer—It shows the total distance
the vehicle has been driven.
2. Two trip meters—They show two different distances independently driven
since the last time each trip meter was
set to zero.
You can use one trip meter to calculate
the fuel economy and the other to
measure the distance on each trip. All
trip meter data is cancelled if the electrical power source is disconnected.
To reset the trip meter A to zero, display the meter A reading, then push
and hold the knob until the meter is
set to zero. The same process can be
applied for resetting the trip meter B.
Do this .
If the indicator or
buzzer comes on...
( a)
(type A)
If parking brake
is off, stop and
check.
(type B)
(b)
Fasten seat belts.
(Indicator and buzzer)
(c)
Stop and check.
(d)
Take vehicle to
Toyota dealer.
(e)
Low fuel level
warning light
Fill up tank.
87
’99camry U
If the indicator or
buzzer comes on...
Do this.
If the indicator or
buzzer comes on...
Do this.
(a) Brake System Warning Light
This light has the following functions:
Parking brake reminder
(f)
(g)
(type A)
Stop and check .
(k)
Add washer fluid.
If this light is on, make sure the parking
brake is fully released. The light should
go off.
Take vehicle to
Toyota dealer
immediately.
(l)
Take vehicle to
Toyota dealer.
Low brake fluid level warning
(type B)
(h)
(m)
Close all doors.
(i)
Replace bulb.
(j)
Take vehicle to
Toyota dealer
immediately.
Key reminder
buzzer
Remove key.
If this light comes on and stays on while
you are driving, slow down and pull off
the road. Then stop the vehicle carefully.
Remember that stopping distance and pedal effort may be increased. There may be
a problem somewhere in the brake system. Check the fluid level of the see–
through reservoir.
To make sure the parking brake has not
caused the warning light to come on,
check to see that the parking brake is
fully released.
If the brake fluid level is low...
At a safe place, test your brakes by starting and stopping.
If you judge that the brakes still work
adequately, drive cautiously to your
nearest dealer or shop for repairs.
If the brakes are not working, have the
vehicle towed in for repairs. (For towing information, see Part 4.)
88
’99camry U
It is dangerous to continue driving
normally when the brake fluid level is
low.
If the brake fluid level is correct...
Have the warning system checked by your
Toyota dealer.
(b) Seat Belt Reminder Light and Buzzer
Once the ignition key is turned to ”ON” or
”START”, the reminder light and buzzer
come on if the driver’s seat belt is not
fastened. Unless the driver fastens the
belt, the light stays on and the buzzer
stops after about 4 to 8 seconds.
(c) Discharge Warning Light
This light warns that the battery is being
discharged.
If it comes on while you are driving, there
is a problem somewhere in the charging
system.
The engine ignition will continue to operate, however, until the battery is discharged. Turn off the air conditioning,
blower, radio, etc., and drive directly to
the nearest Toyota dealer or repair shop.
(f) Low Oil Pressure Warning Light
NOTICE
CAUTION
Do not continue driving if the engine
drive belt is broken or loose.
(d) Malfunction Indicator Lamp
This lamp
cases.
comes
on
in
the
following
a. The fuel tank is completely empty. (See
”Fuel gauge” in Chapter 1–5 for instructions.)
b. The fuel tank cap is not tightened securely. (See ”Fuel tank cap” in Chapter
1–2 for instructions.)
c. There is a problem somewhere in your
engine or automatic transmission electrical
system.
If it comes on while you are driving in
case c, have your vehicle checked/repaired by your Toyota dealer as soon as
possible.
(e) Low Fuel Level Warning Light
This light warns that the engine oil pressure is too low.
If it flickers or stays on while you are
driving, pull off the road to a safe place
and stop the engine immediately. Call a
Toyota dealer or qualified repair shop for
assistance.
The light may occasionally flicker when
the engine is idling or it may come on
briefly after a hard stop. There is no
cause for concern if it then goes out when
the engine is accelerated slightly.
The light may come on when the oil level
is extremely low. It is not designed to
indicate low oil level, and the oil level
must be checked using the level dipstick.
NOTICE
Do not drive the vehicle with the
warning light on—even for one block.
It may ruin the engine.
This light comes on when the fuel level
in the tank becomes nearly empty. Fill up
the tank as soon as possible.
On inclines or curves, due to the movement of fuel in the tank, the low fuel level
warning light may come on earlier than
usual.
89
’99camry U
(g) ”ABS” Warning Light
This light warns that there is a problem
somewhere in your anti–lock brake system.
If the light comes on while you are driving, have your vehicle checked by your
Toyota dealer as soon as possible.
The light will come on when the ignition
key is turned to the ”ON” position. After
a few seconds, the light will go off.
When the ”ABS” warning light is on (and
the brake system warning light is off), the
brake system operates conventionally but
anti–lock brake system is not assisting
brake performance so that the wheels can
lock–up during sudden braking or braking
on slippery road surfaces.
(h) Open Door Warning Light
This light remains on until all the doors
and back door are completely closed.
(i) Rear Light Failure Warning Light
If this light comes on when the headlight
switch is turned on (at the first or second
clickstop), it indicates that one or more of
the tail lights are burned out.
If it comes on when the brake pedal is
depressed, one or more stop lights are
burned out.
Have defective bulbs replaced as soon as
possible.
(j) SRS Airbag Warning Light
This light will come on when the ignition key is turned to the ”ACC” or
”ON” position. After about 6 seconds,
the light will go off. This means the
systems of the airbag and front seat
belt pretensioner are operating properly.
The warning light system monitors the
front airbag sensors, airbag sensor assembly, seat belt pretensioner assemblies,
inflators, warning light, interconnecting wiring and power sources.
The light warns that the windshield washer
fluid level is too low. Add washer fluid at
your earliest opportunity. (For instructions,
see ”Adding washer fluid” in Chapter 7–3.)
(l) ”TRAC OFF” Indicator/Warning Light
This light
is turned
seconds.
operating
comes on when the ignition key
to ”ON”, and will go off after 3
This means that the system is
properly.
If one of the following conditions occurs,
this indicates a malfunction somewhere in
the parts monitored by the warning light
system. Contact your Toyota dealer as
soon as possible to service the vehicle.
The light remains on more than 3 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
on.
If either of the following conditions occurs,
this indicates a malfunction somewhere in
the parts monitored by the warning light
system. Contact your Toyota dealer as
soon as possible to service the vehicle.
The light comes on while driving even
The light does not come on when the
The light flashes.
ignition key is turned to the ”ACC” or
”ON” position or remains on.
The light comes on or flashes while
driving.
90
(k) Low Windshield Washer Fluid Level
Warning Light
if the ”TRAC
pushed.
OFF”
switch
is
not
’99camry U
(m) Key Reminder Buzzer
This buzzer reminds you to remove the
key when you open the driver’s door with
the ignition key in the ”ACC” or ”LOCK”
position.
CHECKING SERVICE REMINDER INDICATORS (except the low fuel level warning
light and low windshield washer fluid
level warning light)
If any service reminder indicator or warning buzzer does not function as described
above, either the bulb is burned out or the
circuit is in need of repair. Have it
checked by your Toyota dealer as soon as
possible.
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. Open one of the doors.
The open door warning light should
come on.
3. Close the door.
The open door warning light should go
off.
4. Turn the ignition key to ”ACC”.
The SRS airbag warning light should
come on. It goes off after about 6 seconds.
5. Turn the ignition key to ”ON”, but do
not start the engine.
All the service reminder indicators except the open door warning light, SRS
airbag warning light and low windshield
washer fluid level warning light should
come on. The ”ABS” warning light goes
off after a few seconds.
91
’99camry U
92
’99camry U
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Ignition switch with steering
lock
You must push in the key to turn the key
from ”ACC” to the ”LOCK” position. On
vehicles with an automatic transmission,
the selector lever must be put in the ”P”
position before pushing the key.
Vehicles with engine immobiliser system—
Once you remove the key, the engine immobiliser system is automatically set. (See
”Engine immobiliser system” in Chapter
1–2.)
Chapter 1–6
Ignition switch,
Transmission and
Parking brake
Ignition switch with steering lock
Automatic transmission
Manual transmission
Parking brake
Cruise control
”START”—Starter motor on. The key
will return to the ”ON” position when
released.
For starting tips, see Part 3.
”ON”—Engine on and all accessories
on.
This is the normal driving position.
”ACC”—Accessories such as the radio
operate, but the engine is off.
When starting the engine, the key may
seem stuck at the ”LOCK” position. To
free it, first be sure the key is pushed all
the way in, and then rock the steering
wheel slightly while turning the key gently.
CAUTION
For manual transmission:
Never remove the key when the vehicle is moving, as this will lock the
steering wheel and result in loss of
steering control.
If you leave the key in the ”ACC” or
”LOCK” position and open the driver’s
door, a buzzer will remind you to remove
the key.
”LOCK”—Engine is off and the steering
wheel is locked. The key can be removed only at this position.
93
’99camry U
NOTICE
Do not leave the key in the ”ON”
position if the engine is not running.
The battery will discharge and the
ignition could be damaged.
94
’99camry U
Automatic transmission
Lock release button
To prevent misshifting
Parking, engine
starting and key
removal postition
Reverse position
Overdrive switch
For selecting either a three–speed
or four–speed transmission
ON position
(Shifting into overdrive
possible)
Neutral position
Normal driving position
Position for engine
braking
Position for stronger
engine braking than
that in ”2” position
With the brake pedal depressed,
shift while holding the lock
release button in. (The ignition
switch must be in ”ON” position.)
Shift while holding the lock
release button in
OFF position
(Shifting into overdrive
not possible)
”O/D OFF” indicator light
shows the overdrive
switch is in OFF position
Shift normally
Vehicles with cruise controlWhen the cruise control is being used, even if you downshift the transmission by turning off the overdrive
switch, engine braking will not be applied because the cruise control is not cancelled. For ways to decrease the vehicle speed, see
”Cruise control” in this chapter.
95
’99camry U
Your automatic transmission has a shift
lock system to minimize the possibility of
incorrect operation. This means you can
only shift out of ”P” position when the
brake pedal is depressed (with the ignition
switch in ”ON” position and the lock release button depressed).
(a) Normal driving
1. Start the engine as instructed in ”How
to start the engine” in Part 3. The
transmission must be in ”P” or ”N”.
2. With your foot holding down the brake
pedal, shift the selector lever to ”D”.
In ”D” position, the automatic transmission
system will select the most suitable gear
for the running conditions such as normal
cruising, hill climbing, hard towing, etc.
Always turn the overdrive switch on for
better fuel economy and quieter driving. If
the engine coolant temperature is low, the
transmission will not shift into overdrive
gear even with the overdrive switch on.
CAUTION
Never put your foot on the accelerator pedal while shifting.
96
3. Release the parking brake and brake
pedal. Depress the accelerator pedal
slowly for smooth starting.
(b) Using engine braking
To use engine braking, you can downshift
the transmission as follows:
Turn off the overdrive switch. The ”O/D
OFF” indicator light will come on and
the transmission will downshift to the
third gear.
Shift into the ”2” position. The transmission will downshift to the second
gear when the vehicle speed drops
down to or lower than the following
speed, and more powerful engine braking will be obtained.
5S–FE engine . . . 106 km/h (65 mph)
1MZ–FE engine . . 122 km/h (75 mph)
Shift into the ”L” position. The transmission will downshift to the first gear
When the vehicle speed drops down to
or lower than the following speed, and
maximum engine braking will be applied.
5S–FE engine . . .
1MZ–FE engine . .
46 km/h (28 mph)
55 km/h (34 mph)
Vehicles with cruise controlWhen the
cruise control is being used, even if you
downshift the transmission by turning off
the overdrive switch, engine braking is not
applied because the cruise control is not
cancelled.
For ways to decrease the vehicle speed,
see ”Cruise control” in this chapter.
CAUTION
Be careful when downshifting on a
slippery
surface.
Abrupt
shifting
could cause the vehicle to spin or
skid.
(c) Using ”2” and ”L” positions
The ”2” and ”L” positions are used for
strong engine braking as described previously.
With the selector lever in ”2” or ”L”, you
can start the vehicle in motion as with the
lever in ”D”.
With the selector lever in ”2”, the vehicle
will start in the first gear and automatically shift to the second gear.
With the selector lever in ”L”, the transmission is engaged in the first gear.
’99camry U
NOTICE
Be careful not to overrev the engine. Watch the tachometer to keep
engine rpm from going into the red
zone. The approximate maximum allowable speed for each position is
given below for your reference:
”2” . . . . . . . . . 125 km/h (77 mph)
”L” . . . . . . . . . . 69 km/h (42 mph)
Do not continue hill climbing or
hard towing for a long time in the
”2” or ”L” position. This may cause
severe automatic transmission damage from overheating. To prevent
such damage, ”D” position should
be used in hill climbing or hard
towing.
(e) Parking
1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.
2. Pull the parking brake lever up fully to
securely apply the parking brake.
3. With the brake pedal pressed down,
shift the selector lever to the ”P” position.
CAUTION
While the vehicle is moving, never
attempt to move the selector lever
into ”P” position under any circumstances. Serious mechanical damage
and loss of vehicle control may result.
CAUTION
Always keep your foot on the brake
pedal while stopped with the engine
running. This prevents the vehicle
from creeping.
NOTICE
Do not hold the vehicle on an upgrade with the accelerator pedal. It
can cause the transmission to overheat. Always use the brake pedal or
parking brake.
(f) Good driving practice
If the transmission is repeatedly up-
(d) Backing up
1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.
2. With the brake pedal held down with
your foot, shift the selector lever to the
”R” position.
NOTICE
Never shift into reverse while the vehicle is moving.
shifted and downshifted between the
third gear and overdrive when climbing
a gentle slope, the overdrive switch
should be turned off. Be sure to turn
the switch on immediately afterward.
When towing a trailer, in order to maintain engine braking efficiency, do not
use overdrive.
97
’99camry U
Manual transmission
(g) Rocking your vehicle if stuck
CAUTION
If your vehicle becomes stuck in
snow, mud, sand, etc., then you may
attempt to rock your vehicle free by
moving it forward and backward. Do
not attempt this procedure if people
or objects are anywhere near the vehicle. During the rocking operation
the vehicle may suddenly move forward or backward as it becomes unstuck, causing injury or damage to
nearby people or objects.
NOTICE
If you rock your vehicle, observe the
following precautions to prevent damage to the transmission and other
parts.
Do not depress the accelerator pedal while shifting the selector lever
or before the transmission is completely shifted to forward or reverse
gear.
Do not race the engine and avoid
spinning the wheels.
98
If your vehicle remains stuck after
rocking the vehicle several times,
consider other ways such as towing.
(h) If you cannot shift the selector lever out of ”P” position
If you cannot shift the selector lever from
”P” position even though the brake pedal
is depressed, use the shift lock override
button. For instructions, see ”If you cannot
shift automatic transmission selector lever”
in Part 4.
The shift pattern is conventional as
shown above.
Press the clutch pedal down fully while
shifting, and then release it slowly. Do not
rest your foot on the pedal while driving,
because it will cause clutch trouble. And
do not use the clutch to hold the vehicle
when stopped on an uphill grade—use the
parking brake.
Recommended shifting speeds
The transmission is fully synchronized and
upshifting or downshifting is easy.
For the best compromise between fuel
economy and vehicle performance, you
should upshift or downshift at the following
speeds:
’99camry U
Parking brake
1
2
3
4
to
to
to
to
2
3
4
5
gear
or 2
or 3
or 4
or 5
to
to
to
to
1
2
3
4
km/h
24
40
64
72
(mph)
(15)
(25)
(40)
(45)
Downshift to the appropriate gear if acceleration is needed when you are cruising
below the above downshifting speeds.
Upshifting too soon or downshifting too
late will cause lugging, and possibly pinging. Regularly revving the engine to maximum speed in each gear will cause excessive engine wear and high fuel
consumption.
Maximum allowable speeds
To get on a highway or to pass slower
traffic, maximum acceleration may be necessary. Make sure you observe the following maximum allowable speeds in each
gear:
gear
1
2
3
km/h
52
93
147
Good driving practice
If it is difficult to shift into reverse, put
the transmission in neutral, release the
clutch pedal momentarily, and then try
again.
When towing a trailer, in order to maintain engine braking efficiency, do not
use the fifth gear.
CAUTION
Be careful when downshifting on a
slippery
surface.
Abrupt
shifting
could cause the vehicle to spin or
skid.
Type A
NOTICE
Make sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before shifting into reverse.
(mph)
(32)
(57)
(91)
NOTICE
Do not downshift if you are going
faster than the maximum allowable
speed for the next lower gear.
Type B
99
’99camry U
Cruise control
When parking, firmly apply the parking
brake to avoid inadvertent creeping.
To set: Pull up the lever. For better holding power, first depress the brake pedal
and hold it while setting the brake.
To release: Pull up the lever slightly,
press the thumb button, and lower.
The cruise control allows you to cruise
the vehicle at a desired speed over 40
km/h (25 mph) even with your foot off
the accelerator pedal.
To remind you that the parking brake is
set, the parking brake reminder light in
the instrument panel remains on until you
release the parking brake.
Your cruising speed can be maintained up
or down grades within the limits of engine
performance, although a slight speed
change may occur when driving up or
down the grades. On steeper hills, a
greater speed change will occur so it is
better to drive without the cruise control.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Before driving, be sure the parking
brake is fully released and the parking brake reminder light is off.
To help maintain maximum control
of your vehicle, do not use the
cruise control when driving in
heavy or varying traffic, or on slippery (rainy, icy or snow–covered) or
winding roads.
Avoid vehicle speed increases when
driving downhill. If the vehicle
speed is too fast in relation to the
cruise control set speed, cancel the
cruise control then downshift the
transmission to use engine braking
to slow down.
100
TURNING ON THE SYSTEM
To operate the cruise control, press the
”CRUISE ON–OFF” button. This turns the
system on. The indicator light in the
instrument panel shows that you can now
set the vehicle at a desired cruising
speed. Another press will turn the system
completely off.
CAUTION
To avoid accidental cruise control engagement, keep the ”CRUISE ON–
OFF” switch off when not using the
cruise control.
’99camry U
If you need acceleration—for example,
when passing—depress the accelerator
pedal enough for the vehicle to exceed
the set speed. When you release it, the
vehicle will return to the speed set prior
to the acceleration.
CAUTION
For manual transmission:
SETTING AT A DESIRED SPEED
On vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission must be in ”D” before
you set the cruise control speed.
Bring your vehicle to the desired speed,
push the lever down in the ”SET/COAST”
direction and release it. This sets the vehicle at that speed. If the speed is not
satisfactory, tap the lever up for a faster
speed, or tap it down for a slower speed.
Each tap changes the set speed by 1.6
km/h (1.0 mph). You can now take your
foot off the accelerator pedal.
While driving with the cruise control
on, do not shift to neutral without
depressing the clutch pedal, as this
may cause engine racing or overrevving.
CANCELLING THE PRESET SPEED
You can cancel the preset speed by:
a. Pulling the lever in the ”CANCEL”
direction and releasing it.
b. Depressing the brake pedal.
c. Depressing the clutch pedal (manual
transmission).
If the preset speed automatically cancels
out other than for the above cases, have
your vehicle checked by your Toyota dealer at the earliest opportunity.
RESETTING AT A FASTER SPEED
Push the lever up in the ”RES/ACC” direction and hold it. Release the lever when
the desired speed is attained. While the
lever is held up, the vehicle will gradually
gain speed.
However, a faster way to reset is to accelerate the vehicle and then push the
lever down in the ”SET/COAST” direction.
RESETTING AT A SLOWER SPEED
Push the lever down in the ”SET/COAST”
direction and hold it. Release the lever
when the desired speed is attained. While
the lever is held down, the vehicle speed
will gradually decrease.
However, a faster way to reset is to depress the brake pedal and then push the
lever down in the ”SET/COAST” direction.
If the vehicle speed falls below about 40
km/h (25 mph), the preset speed will automatically cancel out.
If the vehicle speed drops 16 km/h (10
mph) below the preset speed,the preset
speed will also automatically cancel out.
101
’99camry U
On vehicles with automatic transmission,
even if you turn off the overdrive switch,
with the cruise control on, engine braking
will not be applied because the cruise
control is not cancelled. To decrease the
vehicle speed, reset to a slower speed
with the cruise control lever or depress
the brake pedal. If you use the brake
pedal, cruise control is cancelled.
RESUMING THE PRESET SPEED
If the preset speed is cancelled by pulling
the control lever or by depressing the
brake pedal or clutch pedal, pushing the
lever up in the ”RES/ACC” direction will
restore the speed set prior to cancellation.
However, once the vehicle speed falls below about 40 km/h (25 mph), the preset
speed will not be resumed.
CRUISE CONTROL FAILURE WARNING
If the ”CRUISE” indicator light in the
instrument cluster flashes when using the
cruise control, press the ”CRUISE ON–
OFF” button to turn the system off and
then press it again to turn it on.
If any of the following conditions then occurs, there is some trouble in the cruise
control system.
102
The indicator light does not come on.
The indicator light flashes again.
The indicator light goes out after it
comes on.
If this is the case, contact your Toyota
dealer and have your vehicle inspected.
’99camry U
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Car audio system—
—Reference
Chapter 1–7
Car audio system
and Air conditioning
system
Car audio system
Reference
Type 1: AM· FM ETR radio/cassette player/
compact disc auto changer controller
Type 3: AM· FM ETR radio/cassette player/
compact disc auto changer controller
Type 2: AM· FM ETR radio/compact disc
player/compact disc auto changer controller
Type 4: AM·FM ETR radio/cassette player/compact
disc player/compact disc auto changer controller
Using your audio system:
some basics
Using your audio system:
controls and features
Car audio system operating hints
Air conditioning system
Controls
Air flow selector settings
Operating tips
Side vents
103
’99camry U
—Using your audio system:
some basics
This section describes some of the basic
features on Toyota audio systems. Some
information may not pertain to your system.
TONE AND BALANCE
Your audio system works when the ignition
key is in the ”ACC” or ”ON” position.
Tone
TURNING THE SYSTEM ON AND OFF
Push ”PWR·VOL”, ”PWR/VOL” or ”VOL/
PWR” to turn the audio system on and
off.
Type 5: AM·FM ETR radio/cassette player/compact
disc player/compact disc auto changer controller
Push ”AM”, ”FM”, ”AM·FM”, ”TAPE” or
”CD” to turn on that function without pushing ”PWR·VOL”, ”PWR/VOL” or ”VOL/
PWR”.
You can turn on each player by inserting
a cassette tape or compact disc.
You can turn off each player by ejecting
the cassette tape or compact disc. If the
audio system was previously off, then the
entire audio system will be turned off
when you eject the cassette tape or compact disc. If the another function was previously playing, it will come on again.
SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNCTIONS
Push ”AM”, ”FM”, ”AM·FM”, ”TAPE” or
”CD” if the system is already on but you
want to switch from one function to another.
104
For details about your system’s tone and
balance controls, see the description of
your own system.
How good an audio program sounds to
you is largely determined by the mix of
the treble, midrange, and bass levels. In
fact, different kinds of music and vocal
programs usually sound better with different mixes of treble, midrange, and bass.
Balance
A good balance of the left and right stereo
channels and of the front and rear sound
levels is also important.
Keep in mind that if you are listening to
a stereo recording or broadcast, changing
the right/left balance will increase the volume of one group of sounds while decreasing the volume of another.
’99camry U
YOUR RADIO ANTENNA
NOTICE
Attaching the film (especially conductive or metallic type) on the rear
glass will noticeably reduce the sensitivity of the radio.
YOUR CASSETTE PLAYER
When you insert a cassette, the exposed
tape should be to the right.
NOTICE
Do not oil any part of the player and
do not insert anything other than cassette tapes into the slot, or the tape
player may be damaged.
YOUR COMPACT DISC PLAYER
When you insert a disc, gently push it in
with the label side up. (The player will
automatically eject a disc if the label side
is down.) The compact disc player will
play from track 1 through the end of the
disc. Then it will play from track 1 again.
NOTICE
Never try to disassemble or oil any
part of the compact disc player. Do
not insert anything except a compact
disc into the slot.
8 cm (3 in.) compact disc singles
Your compact disc player does not need
an adaptor to play compact disc singles.
Compact disc singles are about 8 cm (3
in.) in diameter–smaller than standard
discs.
After you eject a compact disc single, do
not insert a standard 12 cm (5 in.) disc
until ”DISC” disappears from the display.
NOTICE
Do not use an adaptor for compact
disc singles—it could cause tracking
errors or interfere with the ejection of
compact discs.
105
’99camry U
—Using your audio system:
controls and features
Type 1
Details of specific buttons, controls and
features are described in the alphabetical
listing that follows.
106
’99camry U
1 2 3 4 5 6 (Preset buttons)
These buttons are used to preset and
tune in radio stations.
To preset a station to a button: Tune in
the desired station (see ”TUNE” button).
Push and hold down the button until you
hear a beep—this will set the station to
the button. The button number will appear
on the display.
To tune in to a preset station: Push the
button for the station you want. The button number and station frequency will appear on the display.
These systems can store one AM and two
FM stations for each button (The display
will show ”AM”, ”FM1” or ”FM2” when you
push ”AM” or ”FM”).
(Eject button)
Push this button to eject a cassette.
After you turn the ignition to ”LOCK”, you
will be able to eject a cassette but you
will not be able to reinsert it.
(Reverse/Fast forward buttons)
Cassette Player
Push the fast forward button to fast forward a cassette tape. ”FF” will appear on
the display. Push the reverse button to
rewind a tape. ”REW” will appear on the
display.
To stop the tape while it is fast forwarding, push the fast forward button or
”TAPE”; to stop the tape while it is rewinding, push the reverse button or
”TAPE”.
If a tape side rewinds completely, the cassette player will stop and then play that
same side. If a tape fast forwards completely, the cassette player will play the
other side of the tape, using the auto–reverse feature.
Compact Disc Player
If you want to fast forward or reverse
through a compact disc track, push and
hold in the fast forward or reverse button.
When you release the button, the compact
disc player will resume playing.
AM
Push ”AM” to switch the AM band. ”AM”
will appear on the display.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the radio by pushing ”AM”. Also, push
”AM” to switch from cassette or compact
disc operation to radio operation.
AUDIO CONTROL / MODE
Manual tone adjustment function—
This knob is used to adjust the tone
manually.
For low–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”BAS” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from
”BAS –5” to ”BAS 5”.
For high–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”TRE” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from
”TRE –5” to ”TRE 5”.
107
’99camry U
Sound balance adjustment function—
CD (Compact Disc)
This knob is also used to adjust the
sound balance between the front and rear,
and the right and left speakers.
Push ”CD” to switch from radio or cassette operation to compact disc operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the compact disc player by pushing
”CD”. In both cases, a disc must already
be loaded in the player.
For front/rear adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”FAd”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the front/rear balance.
The display will show the range from ”FAd
F7” to ”FAd R7”.
For left/right adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”BAL”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the left/right balance.
The display will show the range from ”BAL
L7” to ”BAL R7”.
If ”Err 3” or ”Err 4” on the display, it
indicates there is a trouble inside the system. Eject the disc or magazine. Set the
disc or magazine again.
When the audio is set into compact disc
operation, the display shows the track or,
track and disc number currently being
played. Each time you push ”CD”, the
system changes between single disc player and automatic changer.
If ”OPEn” appears on the display, it
indicates the compact disc auto changer
lid is open. Close the compact disc auto
changer lid.
If the player malfunctions, your audio system will display one of the six following
error messages.
DISC
If ”WAIT” appears on the display, it indicates inside the player unit may be too
hot due to the very high ambient temperature. Remove the disc or magazine from
the player and allow the player to cool
down.
By using this button, you can select a
disc you wish to listen to.
If ”Err 1” appears on the display, it
indicates the disc is dirty, damaged, or it
was inserted up–side down. Clean the
disc or insert it correctly.
108
If ”Err 2” appears on the display, it
indicates no disc is loaded inside the
magazine, insert a disc.
If the malfunction is not rectified, take
your vehicle to your Toyota dealer.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Push either side of the button until the
number of the disc you want to listen to
appears on the display.
’99camry U
Dolby
B NR∗
If you are listening to a tape that was
recorded with Dolby B Noise Reduction,
push the button marked with the double–D
symbol. The double–D symbol will appear
on the display. Push the button again to
turn off Dolby B NR.
The Dolby NR mode reduces tape noise
by about 10 dB. For best sound reproduction, play your tapes with this button on
or off according to the mode used for
recording the tape.
∗ : Dolby noise reduction manufactured under license from
Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. ”DOLBY” and the
double D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories
Licensing Corporation.
FM
RAND (Random)
Push ”FM” to switch the FM band. ”FM1”
or ”FM2” will appear on the display. This
system allows you to set twelve FM stations, two for each button.
There are two random features—you can
either listen to the tracks on all the compact discs in the magazine in random order, or only listen to the tracks on a
specific compact disc in random order.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the radio by pushing ”FM”. Also, push
”FM” to switch from cassette or compact
disc operation to radio operation.
PROG (Program)
Push ”PROG” to select the other side of
a cassette tape. The display indicates
which side is currently selected (” ” indicates top side, ” ” indicates bottom
side).
Auto–reverse feature: After the cassette
player reaches the end of a tape side, it
automatically reverses and begins to play
the other side. This is true whether the
cassette was playing or fast forwarding.
Random playing for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”RAND”. ”RAND”
will appear on the display. The disc you
are listening to will play in random order.
If you hear a beep, you held the button
too long, and the player will play all the
tracks in the magazine in random order.
To turn off the random feature, push the
”RAND” a second time.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Random playing for all the tracks in the
magazine:
Push and hold ”RAND” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RAND” will appear on the display
and the player will perform all the tracks
on all the discs in the magazine in random order. To turn off the random feature,
push ”RAND” a second time.
109
’99camry U
RPT (Repeat)
SCAN
Compact disc player
There are two repeat features—you can
either replay a disc track or a whole compact disc.
Radio
There are two scan features—you can either scan the tracks on a specific disc or
scan the first tracks of all the discs in the
magazine.
Repeating a track:
Quickly push and release ”RPT” while the
track is playing. ”RPT” will appear on the
display. If you hear a beep, you held the
button too long, and the player will repeat
the whole disc. When the track ends, it
will automatically be replayed. This process will be continued until you push the
button again to turn off the repeat feature.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Repeating a disc:
Push and hold ”RPT” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RPT” will appear on the display.
The player will repeat all the tracks on the
disc you are listening to. When the disc
ends, the player will automatically go back
to the top track of the disc and replay.
This process will be continued until you
push the button again to turn off the repeat feature.
110
You can either scan all the frequencies on
a band or scan only the preset stations
for that band.
To scan the preset stations:
Push and hold ”SCAN” until you hear a
beep. The radio will tune in the next preset station up the band, stay there for a
few seconds, and then move to the next
preset station. To select a station, push
”SCAN” a second time.
To scan all the frequencies:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. If you
hear a beep, you held the button too long,
and the radio will scan the preset stations. The radio will find the next station
up the station band, stay there for a few
seconds, and then scan again. To select
a station, push ”SCAN” a second time.
Scanning for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. ”SCAN”
will appear on the display and the player
will scan all the tracks on the disc you
are listening to. If you hear a beep, you
held the button too long, and the player
will scan the first tracks of all the discs
in the magazine. To select a track, push
the ”SCAN” a second time. If the player
scanned all the tracks on the disc, it will
stop scanning.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Scanning for the first tracks of all the
discs in the magazine:
Push and hold ”SCAN” until you hear a
beep. ”D·SCAN” will appear on the display
and the player will perform the first track
of the next disc. To select a disc, push
the ”SCAN” a second time. If the player
has scanned all the discs, it will stop
scanning.
’99camry U
ST (Stereo reception) display
TUNE
Your radio automatically changes to stereo
reception when a stereo broadcast is received. ”ST” appears on the display. If the
signal becomes weak, the radio reduces
the amount of channel separation to prevent the weak signal from creating noise.
If the signal becomes extremely weak, the
radio switches from stereo to mono reception.
Tuning
TAPE
In the seek mode, the radio finds and
plays the next station up or down the
station band.
Push ”TAPE” to switch from radio or compact disc operation to cassette operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the cassette player by pushing ”TAPE”.
In both cases, a cassette must already be
loaded in the player.
TRACK
(Track
up/down
Compact disc player
button):
By using this button, you can skip up or
down to a different track.
Your Toyota has an electronic tuning radio
(ETR). Push and release the ”” (up) or
”” (down) side of ”TUNE” to step up or
down the station band. (If you hear a
beep, you held the button too long and
the radio will go into the seek mode.)
Seeking
To seek a station, push and hold the ””
or ”” side of ”TUNE” until you hear a
beep. Do this again to find another station.
VOL/PWR (Volume/Power)
Push ”VOL/PWR” to turn the audio system
on and off. Turn ”VOL/PWR” to adjust the
volume.
Push either side of the track button until
the number of the track you want to listen
to appears on the display. If you want to
return to the beginning of the current
track, push the down side of the button
one time, quickly.
111
’99camry U
Type 2
Details of specific buttons, controls, and
features are described in the alphabetical
listing that follows.
112
’99camry U
1 2 3 4 5 6 (Preset buttons)
These buttons are used to preset and
tune in radio stations.
To preset a station to a button: Tune in
the desired station (see ”TUNE” button).
Push and hold down the button until you
hear a beep—this will set the station to
the button. The button number will appear
on the display.
To tune in to a preset station: Push the
button for the station you want. The button number and station frequency will appear on the display.
These systems can store one AM and two
FM stations for each button (The display
will show ”AM”, ”FM1” or ”FM2” when you
push ”AM” or ”FM”).
(Eject button)
Push this button to eject a compact disc.
After you turn the ignition to ”LOCK”, you
will be able to eject a disc but you will
not be able to reinsert it.
(Reverse/Fast forward buttons)
If you want to fast forward or reverse
through a compact disc track, push and
hold in the fast forward or reverse button.
When you release the button, the compact
disc player will resume playing.
AM⋅FM
Push ”AM⋅FM” to switch between the AM
and FM bands. ”AM”, ”FM1” or ”FM2” will
appear on the display. These systems allow you to set twelve FM stations, two for
each button.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the radio by pushing ”AM⋅FM”. Also,
push ”AM⋅FM” to switch from compact
disc operation to radio operation.
AUDIO CONTROL / MODE
Manual tone adjustment function—
This knob is used to adjust the tone
manually.
For low–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”BAS” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from
”BAS –5” to ”BAS 5”.
With middle–pitch tone—
For middle–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”Mld” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from ”Mld
–5” to ”Mld 5”.
For high–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”TRE” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from
”TRE –5” to ”TRE 5”.
113
’99camry U
Sound balance adjustment function—
CD (Compact Disc)
This knob is also used to adjust the
sound balance between the front and rear,
and the right and left speakers.
Push ”CD” to switch from radio operation
to compact disc operation. If the audio
system is off, you can turn on the compact disc player by pushing ”CD”. In both
cases, a disc must already be loaded in
the player.
For front/rear adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”FAd”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the front/rear balance.
The display will show the range from ”FAd
F7” to ”FAd R7”.
For left/right adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”BAL”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the left/right balance.
The display will show the range from ”BAL
L7” to ”BAL R7”.
114
If ”Err 2” appears on the display, it
indicates no disc is loaded inside the
magazine, insert a disc.
If ”Err 3” or ”Err 4” on the display, it
indicates there is a trouble inside the system. Eject the disc or magazine. Set the
disc or magazine again.
When the audio is set into compact disc
operation, the display shows the track or,
track and disc number currently being
played. Each time you push ”CD”, the
system changes between built–in single
disc player and automatic changer.
If ”OPEn” appears on the display, it
indicates the compact disc auto changer
lid is open. Close the compact disc auto
changer lid.
If the player malfunctions, your audio system will display one of the six following
error messages.
DISC
If ”WAIT” appears on the display, it indicates inside the player unit may be too
hot due to the very high ambient temperature. Remove the disc or magazine from
the player and allow the player to cool
down.
By using this button, you can select a
disc you wish to listen to.
If ”Err 1” appears on the display, it
indicates the disc is dirty, damaged, or it
was inserted up–side down. Clean the
disc or insert it correctly.
Push ”PWR/VOL” to turn the audio system
on and off. Turn ”PWR/VOL” to adjust the
volume.
If the malfunction is not rectified, take
your vehicle to your Toyota dealer.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Push either side of the button until the
number of the disc you want to listen to
appears on the display.
PWR/VOL (Power/Volume)
’99camry U
RAND (Random)
RPT (Repeat)
SCAN
There are two random features—you can
either listen to the tracks on all the compact discs in the magazine in random order, or only listen to the tracks on a
specific compact disc in random order.
There are two repeat features—you can
either replay a disc track or a whole compact disc.
Radio
Random playing for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”RAND”. ”RAND”
will appear on the display. The disc you
are listening to will play in random order.
If you hear a beep, you held the button
too long, and the player will play all the
tracks in the magazine in random order.
To turn off the random feature, push the
”RAND” a second time.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Random playing for all the tracks in the
magazine:
Push and hold ”RAND” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RAND” will appear on the display
and the player will perform all the tracks
on all the discs in the magazine in random order. To turn off the random feature,
push ”RAND” a second time.
Repeating a track:
Quickly push and release ”RPT” while the
track is playing. ”RPT” will appear on the
display. If you hear a beep, you held the
button too long, and the player will repeat
the whole disc. When the track ends, it
will automatically be replayed. This process will be continued until you push the
button again to turn off the repeat feature.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Repeating a disc:
Push and hold ”RPT” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RPT” will appear on the display.
The player will repeat all the tracks on the
disc you are listening to. When the disc
ends, the player will automatically go back
to the top track of the disc and replay.
This process will be continued until you
push the button again to turn off the repeat feature.
You can either scan all the frequencies on
a band or scan only the preset stations
for that band.
To scan the preset stations:
Push and hold ”SCAN” until you hear a
beep. The radio will tune in the next preset station up the band, stay there for a
few seconds, and then move to the next
preset station. To select a station, push
”SCAN” a second time.
To scan all the frequencies:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. If you
hear a beep, you held the button too long,
and the radio will scan the preset stations. The radio will find the next station
up the station band, stay there for a few
seconds, and then scan again. To select
a station, push ”SCAN” a second time.
115
’99camry U
Compact disc player
ST (Stereo reception) display
TUNE (Tuning)
There are two scan features—you can either scan the tracks on a specific disc or
scan the first tracks of all the discs in the
magazine.
Your radio automatically changes to stereo
reception when a stereo broadcast is received. ”ST” appears on the display. If the
signal becomes weak, the radio reduces
the amount of channel separation to prevent the weak signal from creating noise.
If the signal becomes extremely weak, the
radio switches from stereo to mono reception.
Tuning
TRACK
(Track
up/down
Compact disc player
In the seek mode, the radio finds and
plays the next station up or down the
station band.
Scanning for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. ”SCAN”
will appear on the display and the player
will scan all the tracks on the disc you
are listening to. If you hear a beep, you
held the button too long, and the player
will scan the first tracks of all the discs
in the magazine. To select a track, push
the ”SCAN” a second time. If the player
scanned all the tracks on the disc, it will
stop scanning.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Scanning for the first tracks of all the
discs in the magazine:
Push and hold ”SCAN” until you hear a
beep. ”D·SCAN” will appear on the display
and the player will perform the first track
of the next disc. To select a disc, push
the ”SCAN” a second time. If the player
has scanned all the discs, it will stop
scanning.
116
button):
By using this button, you can skip up or
down to a different track.
Push either side of the track button until
the number of the track you want to listen
to appears on the display. If you want to
return to the beginning of the current
track, push the down side of the button
one time, quickly.
Your Toyota has an electronic tuning radio
(ETR). Push and release the ”” (up) or
”” (down) side of ”TUNE” to step up or
down the station band. (If you hear a
beep, you held the button too long and
the radio will go into the seek mode.)
Seeking
To seek a station, push and hold the ””
or ”” side of ”TUNE” until you hear a
beep. Do this again to find another station.
’99camry U
Type 3
Details of specific buttons, controls, and
features are described in the alphabetical
listing that follows.
117
’99camry U
1 2 3 4 5 6 (Preset buttons)
These buttons are used to preset and
tune in radio stations.
To preset a station to a button: Tune in
the desired station (see ”TUNE” or ”SEEK”
button). Push and hold down the button
until you hear a beep—this will set the
station to the button. The button number
will appear on the display.
To tune in to a preset station: Push the
button for the station you want. The button number and station frequency will appear on the display.
These systems can store one AM and two
FM stations for each button (The display
will show ”AM”, ”FM1” or ”FM2” when you
push ”AM” or ”FM”).
(Eject button)
Push this button to eject a cassette.
After you turn the ignition to ”LOCK”, you
will be able to eject a cassette but you
will not be able to reinsert it.
118
(Reverse/Fast forward buttons)
Cassette Player
Push the fast forward button to fast forward a cassette tape. ”FF” will appear on
the display. Push the reverse button to
rewind a tape. ”REW” will appear on the
display.
To stop the tape while it is fast forwarding, push the fast forward button or
”TAPE”; to stop the tape while it is rewinding, push the reverse button or
”TAPE”.
If a tape side rewinds completely, the cassette player will stop and then play that
same side. If a tape fast forwards completely, the cassette player will play the
other side of the tape, using the auto–reverse feature.
Compact Disc Player
If you want to fast forward or reverse
through a compact disc track, push and
hold in the fast forward or reverse button.
When you release the button, the compact
disc player will resume playing.
AM
Push ”AM” to switch the AM band. ”AM”
will appear on the display.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the radio by pushing ”AM”. Also, push
”AM” to switch from cassette or compact
disc operation to radio operation.
AUDIO CONTROL / MODE
Manual tone adjustment function—
This knob is used to adjust the tone
manually.
For low–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”BAS” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from
”BAS –5” to ”BAS 5”.
For middle–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”Mld” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from ”Mld
–5” to ”Mld 5”.
’99camry U
For high–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”TRE” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from
”TRE –5” to ”TRE 5”.
Sound balance adjustment function—
This knob is also used to adjust the
sound balance between the front and rear,
and the right and left speakers.
For front/rear adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”FAd”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the front/rear balance.
The display will show the range from ”FAd
F7” to ”FAd R7”.
For left/right adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”BAL”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the left/right balance.
The display will show the range from ”BAL
L7” to ”BAL R7”.
CD (Compact Disc)
Push ”CD” to switch from radio or cassette operation to compact disc operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the compact disc player by pushing
”CD”. In both cases, a disc must already
be loaded in the player.
If ”Err 2” appears on the display, it
indicates no disc is loaded inside the
magazine, insert a disc.
If ”Err 3” or ”Err 4” on the display, it
indicates there is a trouble inside the system. Eject the disc or magazine. Set the
disc or magazine again.
When the audio is set into compact disc
operation, the display shows the track or,
track and disc number currently being
played. Each time you push ”CD”, the
system changes between single disc player and automatic changer.
If ”OPEn” appears on the display, it
indicates the compact disc auto changer
lid is open. Close the compact disc auto
changer lid.
If the player malfunctions, your audio system will display one of the six following
error messages.
DISC
If ”WAIT” appears on the display, it indicates inside the player unit may be too
hot due to the very high ambient temperature. Remove the disc or magazine from
the player and allow the player to cool
down.
By using this button, you can select a
disc you wish to listen to.
If the malfunction is not rectified, take
your vehicle to your Toyota dealer.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Push either side of the button until the
number of the disc you want to listen to
appears on the display.
If ”Err 1” appears on the display, it
indicates the disc is dirty, damaged, or it
was inserted up–side down. Clean the
disc or insert it correctly.
119
’99camry U
Dolby
B NR∗
If you are listening to a tape that was
recorded with Dolby B Noise Reduction,
push the button marked with the double–D
symbol. The double–D symbol will appear
on the display. Push the button again to
turn off Dolby B NR.
The Dolby NR mode reduces tape noise
by about 10 dB. For best sound reproduction, play your tapes with this button on
or off according to the mode used for
recording the tape.
∗ : Dolby noise reduction manufactured under license from
Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. ”DOLBY” and the
double D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories
Licensing Corporation.
FM
Push ”FM” to switch the FM band. ”FM1”
or ”FM2” will appear on the display. This
system allows you to set twelve FM stations, two for each button.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the radio by pushing ”FM”. Also, push
”FM” to switch from cassette or compact
disc operation to radio operation.
120
MTL (Metal) Display
RAND (Random)
If a metal or chrome equivalent cassette
tape is put in the cassette player, the
player will automatically adapt to it and
”MTL” will appear on the display.
There are two random features—you can
either listen to the tracks on all the compact discs in the magazine in random order, or only listen to the tracks on a
specific compact disc in random order.
PROG (Program)
Push ”PROG” to select the other side of
a cassette tape. The display indicates
which side is currently selected (” ” indicates top side, ” ” indicates bottom
side).
Auto–reverse feature: After the cassette
player reaches the end of a tape side, it
automatically reverses and begins to play
the other side. This is true whether the
cassette was playing or fast forwarding.
Random playing for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”RAND”. ”RAND”
will appear on the display. The disc you
are listening to will play in random order.
If you hear a beep, you held the button
too long, and the player will play all the
tracks in the magazine in random order.
To turn off the random feature, push the
”RAND” a second time.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Random playing for all the tracks in the
magazine:
Push and hold ”RAND” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RAND” will appear on the display
and the player will perform all the tracks
on all the discs in the magazine in random order. To turn off the random feature,
push ”RAND” a second time.
’99camry U
RPT (Repeat)
Compact disc auto changer only—
Cassette Player
Repeating a disc:
Push and hold ”RPT” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RPT” will appear on the display.
The player will repeat all the tracks on the
disc you are listening to. When the disc
ends, the player will automatically go back
to the top track of the disc and replay.
This process will be continued until you
push the button again to turn off the repeat feature.
Push ”RPT” while the track is playing.
”RPT” will appear on the display. When
the track ends, it will automatically be
rewound and replayed. This process will
be continued until you push the button
again to turn off the repeat feature.
There must be at least 3 seconds of blank
space between tracks in order for the repeat feature to work correctly.
Compact Disc Player
There are two repeat features—you can
either replay a disc track or a whole compact disc.
Repeating a track:
Quickly push and release ”RPT” while the
track is playing. ”RPT” will appear on the
display. If you hear a beep, you held the
button too long, and the player will repeat
the whole disc. When the track ends, it
will automatically be replayed. This process will be continued until you push the
button again to turn off the repeat feature.
SCAN
Radio
You can either scan all the frequencies on
a band or scan only the preset stations
for that band.
To scan the preset stations:
Push and hold ”SCAN” until you hear a
beep. The radio will tune in the next preset station up the band, stay there for a
few seconds, and then move to the next
preset station. To select a station, push
”SCAN” a second time.
To scan all the frequencies:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. If you
hear a beep, you held the button too long,
and the radio will scan the preset stations. The radio will find the next station
up the station band, stay there for a few
seconds, and then scan again. To select
a station, push ”SCAN” a second time.
Compact disc player
There are two scan features—you can either scan the tracks on a specific disc or
scan the first tracks of all the discs in the
magazine.
Scanning for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. ”SCAN”
will appear on the display and the player
will scan all the tracks on the disc you
are listening to. If you hear a beep, you
held the button too long, and the player
will scan the first tracks of all the discs
in the magazine. To select a track, push
the ”SCAN” a second time. If the player
scanned all the tracks on the disc, it will
stop scanning.
121
’99camry U
Compact disc auto changer only—
Cassette Player
Scanning for the first tracks of all the
discs in the magazine:
Push and hold ”SCAN” until you hear a
beep. ”D·SCAN” will appear on the display
and the player will perform the first track
of the next disc. To select a disc, push
the ”SCAN” a second time. If the player
has scanned all the discs, it will stop
scanning.
By using this button, you can skip up or
down to a different track.
SEEK (Seeking)
Radio
In the seek mode, the radio finds and
plays the next station up or down the
station band.
To seek a station, push and hold the ””
or ”” side of ”TUNE” until you hear a
beep. Do this again to find another station.
The track number you select is not valid
if it is higher than the number of tracks
remaining on the current cassette side.
You can skip up tp nine tracks at a time.
After the beginning of the tape is
Push the up or down side of the button.
”FF 1” or ”REW 1” will appear on the
display.
After the end of the tape is reached,
Next, push either side of
until the number on the
the number of tracks you
you push the button ten
feature will be turned off.
the track button
display reaches
want to skip. If
times, the skip
When counting the number of tracks you
want to rewind, remember to count the
current track as well. For example, if you
want to rewind to a song that is two before the song you are listening to, push
on the down side of the button until ”REW
3” appears on the display.
If you have pushed the track button more
than you wanted to, push the other side
of the button. The track number will be
reduced.
reached, the player will automatically
start playing the same side.
the player will automatically reverse
sides and start playing the other side.
There must be at least 3 seconds of blank
space between tracks for the track button
to work correctly. In addition, the feature
may not work well with some spoken
word, live, or classical recordings.
SKIP
The skip feature allows you to fast forward past long stretches of blank tape.
This is especially useful at the end of
cassettes.
Push ”SKIP”. ”SKIP” will appear on the
display. The cassette player will keep
track of how much blank space it plays.
Any time it has played about 10 seconds
of blank tape, it will automatically fast
forward to the next track and begin to
play.
Push the button a second time to turn off
the skip feature.
122
’99camry U
ST (Stereo reception) display
TUNE (Tuning)
Your radio automatically changes to stereo
reception when a stereo broadcast is received. ”ST” appears on the display. If the
signal becomes weak, the radio reduces
the amount of channel separation to prevent the weak signal from creating noise.
If the signal becomes extremely weak, the
radio switches from stereo to mono reception.
Your Toyota has an electronic tuning radio
(ETR). Push and release the ”” (up) or
”” (down) side of ”TUNE” to step up or
down the station band. (If you hear a
beep, you held the button too long and
the radio will go into the seek mode.)
TAPE
VOL/PWR (Volume/Power)
Push ”VOL/PWR” to turn the audio system
on and off. Turn ”VOL/PWR” to adjust the
volume.
Push ”TAPE” to switch from radio or compact disc operation to cassette operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the cassette player by pushing ”TAPE”.
In both cases, a cassette must already be
loaded in the player.
TRACK
(Track
up/down
Compact disc player
button):
By using this button, you can skip up or
down to a different track.
Push either side of the track button until
the number of the track you want to listen
to appears on the display. If you want to
return to the beginning of the current
track, push the down side of the button
one time, quickly.
123
’99camry U
Type 4
Details of specific buttons, controls, and
features are described in the alphabetical
listing that follows.
124
’99camry U
1 2 3 4 5 6 (Preset buttons)
These buttons are used to preset and
tune in radio stations.
To preset a station to a button: Tune in
the desired station (see ”TUNE” or ”SEEK”
button). Push and hold down the button
until you hear a beep—this will set the
station to the button. The button number
will appear on the display.
To tune in to a preset station: Push the
button for the station you want. The button number and station frequency will appear on the display.
These systems can store one AM and two
FM stations for each button (The display
will show ”AM”, ”FM1” or ”FM2” when you
push ”AM” or ”FM”).
(Eject button)
Push the cassette tape eject button to
eject a cassette. Push the compact disc
eject button to eject a compact disc.
After you turn the ignition to ”LOCK”, you
will be able to eject a cassette or disc but
you will not be able to reinsert it.
(Reverse/Fast forward buttons)
Cassette Player
Push the fast forward button to fast forward a cassette tape. ”FF” will appear on
the display. Push the reverse button to
rewind a tape. ”REW” will appear on the
display.
To stop the tape while it is fast forwarding, push the fast forward button or
”TAPE”; to stop the tape while it is rewinding, push the reverse button or
”TAPE”.
AM⋅FM
Push ”AM⋅FM” to switch between the AM
and FM bands. ”AM”, ”FM1” or ”FM2” will
appear on the display. These systems allow you to set twelve FM stations, two for
each button.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the radio by pushing ”AM⋅FM”. Also,
push ”AM⋅FM” to switch from cassette or
compact disc operation to radio operation.
AUDIO CONTROL / MODE
Manual tone adjustment function—
If a tape side rewinds completely, the cassette player will stop and then play that
same side. If a tape fast forwards completely, the cassette player will play the
other side of the tape, using the auto–reverse feature.
This knob is used to adjust the tone
manually.
Compact Disc Player
The display will show the range from
”BAS –5” to ”BAS 5”.
If you want to fast forward or reverse
through a compact disc track, push and
hold in the fast forward or reverse button.
When you release the button, the compact
disc player will resume playing.
For low–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”BAS” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
For middle–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”Mld” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from ”Mld
–5” to ”Mld 5”.
125
’99camry U
For high–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”TRE” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from
”TRE –5” to ”TRE 5”.
Sound balance adjustment function—
This knob is also used to adjust the
sound balance between the front and rear,
and the right and left speakers.
For front/rear adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”FAd”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the front/rear balance.
The display will show the range from ”FAd
F7” to ”FAd R7”.
For left/right adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”BAL”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the left/right balance.
The display will show the range from ”BAL
L7” to ”BAL R7”.
126
CD (Compact Disc)
Push ”CD” to switch from radio or cassette operation to compact disc operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the compact disc player by pushing
”CD”. In both cases, a disc must already
be loaded in the player.
If ”Err 2” appears on the display, it
indicates no disc is loaded inside the
magazine, insert a disc.
If ”Err 3” or ”Err 4” on the display, it
indicates there is a trouble inside the system. Eject the disc or magazine. Set the
disc or magazine again.
When the audio is set into compact disc
operation, the display shows the track or,
track and disc number currently being
played. Each time you push ”CD”, the
system changes between built–in single
disc player and automatic changer.
If ”OPEn” appears on the display, it
indicates the compact disc auto changer
lid is open. Close the compact disc auto
changer lid.
If the player malfunctions, your audio system will display one of the six following
error messages.
DISC
If ”WAIT” appears on the display, it indicates inside the player unit may be too
hot due to the very high ambient temperature. Remove the disc or magazine from
the player and allow the player to cool
down.
By using this button, you can select a
disc you wish to listen to.
If ”Err 1” appears on the display, it
indicates the disc is dirty, damaged, or it
was inserted up–side down. Clean the
disc or insert it correctly.
If the malfunction is not rectified, take
your vehicle to your Toyota dealer.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Push either side of the button until the
number of the disc you want to listen to
appears on the display.
’99camry U
Dolby
B NR∗
If you are listening to a tape that was
recorded with Dolby B Noise Reduction,
push the button marked with the double–D
symbol. The double–D symbol will appear
on the display. Push the button again to
turn off Dolby B NR.
The Dolby NR mode reduces tape noise
by about 10 dB. For best sound reproduction, play your tapes with this button on
or off according to the mode used for
recording the tape.
PROG (Program)
Push ”PROG” to select the other side of
a cassette tape. The display indicates
which side is currently selected (” ” indicates top
side).
side,
”
”
indicates
bottom
Auto–reverse feature: After the cassette
player reaches the end of a tape side, it
automatically reverses and begins to play
the other side. This is true whether the
cassette was playing or fast forwarding.
∗ : Dolby noise reduction manufactured under license from
PWR⋅VOL (Power⋅Volume)
Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. ”DOLBY” and the
double D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories
Licensing Corporation.
Push ”PWR⋅VOL” to turn the audio system
on and off. Turn ”PWR⋅VOL” to adjust the
volume.
MTL (Metal) Display
If a metal or chrome equivalent cassette
tape is put in the cassette player, the
player will automatically adapt to it and
”MTL” will appear on the display.
RAND (Random)
There are two random features—you can
either listen to the tracks on all the compact discs in the magazine in random order, or only listen to the tracks on a
specific compact disc in random order.
Random playing for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”RAND”. ”RAND”
will appear on the display. The disc you
are listening to will play in random order.
If you hear a beep, you held the button
too long, and the player will play all the
tracks in the magazine in random order.
To turn off the random feature, push the
”RAND” a second time.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Random playing for all the tracks in the
magazine:
Push and hold ”RAND” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RAND” will appear on the display
and the player will perform all the tracks
on all the discs in the magazine in random order. To turn off the random feature,
push ”RAND” a second time.
RPT (Repeat)
Cassette Player
Push ”RPT” while the track is playing.
”RPT” will appear on the display. When
the track ends, it will automatically be
rewound and replayed. This process will
be continued until you push the button
again to turn off the repeat feature.
There must be at least 3 seconds of blank
space between tracks in order for the repeat feature to work correctly.
127
’99camry U
Compact Disc Player
SCAN
Compact disc player
There are two repeat features—you can
either replay a disc track or a whole compact disc.
Radio
There are two scan features—you can either scan the tracks on a specific disc or
scan the first tracks of all the discs in the
magazine.
Repeating a track:
Quickly push and release ”RPT” while the
track is playing. ”RPT” will appear on the
display. If you hear a beep, you held the
button too long, and the player will repeat
the whole disc. When the track ends, it
will automatically be replayed. This process will be continued until you push the
button again to turn off the repeat feature.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Repeating a disc:
Push and hold ”RPT” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RPT” will appear on the display.
The player will repeat all the tracks on the
disc you are listening to. When the disc
ends, the player will automatically go back
to the top track of the disc and replay.
This process will be continued until you
push the button again to turn off the repeat feature.
128
You can either scan all the frequencies on
a band or scan only the preset stations
for that band.
To scan the preset stations:
Push and hold ”SCAN” until you hear a
beep. The radio will tune in the next preset station up the band, stay there for a
few seconds, and then move to the next
preset station. To select a station, push
”SCAN” a second time.
To scan all the frequencies:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. If you
hear a beep, you held the button too long,
and the radio will scan the preset stations. The radio will find the next station
up the station band, stay there for a few
seconds, and then scan again. To select
a station, push ”SCAN” a second time.
Scanning for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. ”SCAN”
will appear on the display and the player
will scan all the tracks on the disc you
are listening to. If you hear a beep, you
held the button too long, and the player
will scan the first tracks of all the discs
in the magazine. To select a track, push
the ”SCAN” a second time. If the player
scanned all the tracks on the disc, it will
stop scanning.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Scanning for the first tracks of all the
discs in the magazine:
Push ”SCAN” until you hear a beep.
”D·SCAN” will appear on the display and
the player will perform the first track of
the next disc. To select a disc, push the
”SCAN” a second time. If the player has
scanned all the discs, it will stop scanning.
’99camry U
SEEK (Seeking)
Radio
In the seek mode, the radio finds and
plays the next station up or down the
station band.
To seek a station, push and hold the ””
or ”” side of ”TUNE” until you hear a
beep. Do this again to find another station.
Cassette Player
By using this button, you can skip up or
down to a different track.
When counting the number of tracks you
want to rewind, remember to count the
current track as well. For example, if you
want to rewind to a song that is two before the song you are listening to, push
on the down side of the button until ”REW
3” appears on the display.
If you have pushed the track button more
than you wanted to, push the other side
of the button. The track number will be
reduced.
You can skip up tp nine tracks at a time.
The track number you select is not valid
if it is higher than the number of tracks
remaining on the current cassette side.
Push the up or down side of the button.
”FF 1” or ”REW 1” will appear on the
display.
reached, the player will automatically
start playing the same side.
Next, push either side of
until the number on the
the number of tracks you
you push the button ten
feature will be turned off.
the track button
display reaches
want to skip. If
times, the skip
After the beginning of the tape is
After the end of the tape is reached,
the player will automatically reverse
sides and start playing the other side.
There must be at least 3 seconds of blank
space between tracks for the track button
to work correctly. In addition, the feature
may not work well with some spoken
word, live, or classical recordings.
SKIP
The skip feature allows you to fast forward past long stretches of blank tape.
This is especially useful at the end of
cassettes.
Push ”SKIP”. ”SKIP” will appear on the
display. The cassette player will keep
track of how much blank space it plays.
Any time it has played about 10 seconds
of blank tape, it will automatically fast
forward to the next track and begin to
play.
Push the button a second time to turn off
the skip feature.
ST (Stereo reception) display
Your radio automatically changes to stereo
reception when a stereo broadcast is received. ”ST” appears on the display. If the
signal becomes weak, the radio reduces
the amount of channel separation to prevent the weak signal from creating noise.
If the signal becomes extremely weak, the
radio switches from stereo to mono reception.
129
’99camry U
TAPE
Push ”TAPE” to switch from radio or compact disc operation to cassette operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the cassette player by pushing ”TAPE”.
In both cases, a cassette must already be
loaded in the player.
TRACK
(Track
up/down
Compact disc player
button):
By using this button, you can skip up or
down to a different track.
Push either side of the track button until
the number of the track you want to listen
to appears on the display. If you want to
return to the beginning of the current
track, push the down side of the button
one time, quickly.
TUNE (Tuning)
Your Toyota has an electronic tuning radio
(ETR). Push and release the ”” (up) or
”” (down) side of ”TUNE” to step up or
down the station band. (If you hear a
beep, you held the button too long and
the radio will go into the seek mode.)
130
’99camry U
Type 5
Details of specific buttons, controls, and
features are described in the alphabetical
listing that follows.
131
’99camry U
1 2 3 4 5 6 (Preset buttons)
These buttons are used to preset and
tune in radio stations.
To preset a station to a button: Tune in
the desired station (see ”TUNE” or ”SEEK”
button). Push and hold down the button
until you hear a beep—this will set the
station to the button. The button number
will appear on the display.
To tune in to a preset station: Push the
button for the station you want. The button number and station frequency will appear on the display.
These systems can store one AM and two
FM stations for each button (The display
will show ”AM”, ”FM1” or ”FM2” when you
push ”AM” or ”FM”).
(Eject button)
Push the cassette tape eject button to
eject a cassette. Push the compact disc
eject button to eject a compact disc.
After you turn the ignition to ”LOCK”, you
will be able to eject a cassette or disc but
you will not be able to reinsert it.
(Reverse/Fast forward buttons)
Cassette Player
Push the fast forward button to fast forward a cassette tape. ”FF” will appear on
the display. Push the reverse button to
rewind a tape. ”REW” will appear on the
display.
To stop the tape while it is fast forwarding, push the fast forward button or
”TAPE”; to stop the tape while it is rewinding, push the reverse button or
”TAPE”.
AM⋅FM
Push ”AM⋅FM” to switch between the AM
and FM bands. ”AM”, ”FM1” or ”FM2” will
appear on the display. These systems allow you to set twelve FM stations, two for
each button.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the radio by pushing ”AM⋅FM”. Also,
push ”AM⋅FM” to switch from cassette or
compact disc operation to radio operation.
AUDIO CONTROL / MODE
Manual tone adjustment function—
If a tape side rewinds completely, the cassette player will stop and then play that
same side. If a tape fast forwards completely, the cassette player will play the
other side of the tape, using the auto–reverse feature.
This knob is used to adjust the tone
manually.
Compact Disc Player
The display will show the range from
”BAS –5” to ”BAS 5”.
If you want to fast forward or reverse
through a compact disc track, push and
hold in the fast forward or reverse button.
When you release the button, the compact
disc player will resume playing.
For low–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”BAS” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
For high–pitch tone adjustment, push
”AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly
until ”TRE” appears on the display. Then
turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from
”TRE –5” to ”TRE 5”.
132
’99camry U
Sound balance adjustment function—
CD (Compact Disc)
This knob is also used to adjust the
sound balance between the front and rear,
and the right and left speakers.
Push ”CD” to switch from radio or cassette operation to compact disc operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the compact disc player by pushing
”CD”. In both cases, a disc must already
be loaded in the player.
For front/rear adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”FAd”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the front/rear balance.
The display will show the range from ”FAd
F7” to ”FAd R7”.
For left/right adjustment, push ”AUDIO
CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until ”BAL”
appears on the display. Then turn the
knob to adjust the left/right balance.
The display will show the range from ”BAL
L7” to ”BAL R7”.
If ”Err 2” appears on the display, it
indicates no disc is loaded inside the
magazine, insert a disc.
If ”Err 3” or ”Err 4” on the display, it
indicates there is a trouble inside the system. Eject the disc or magazine. Set the
disc or magazine again.
When the audio is set into compact disc
operation, the display shows the track or,
track and disc number currently being
played. Each time you push ”CD”, the
system changes between built–in single
disc player and automatic changer.
If ”OPEn” appears on the display, it
indicates the compact disc auto changer
lid is open. Close the compact disc auto
changer lid.
If the player malfunctions, your audio system will display one of the six following
error messages.
DISC
If ”WAIT” appears on the display, it indicates inside the player unit may be too
hot due to the very high ambient temperature. Remove the disc or magazine from
the player and allow the player to cool
down.
By using this button, you can select a
disc you wish to listen to.
If the malfunction is not rectified, take
your vehicle to your Toyota dealer.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Push either side of the button until the
number of the disc you want to listen to
appears on the display.
If ”Err 1” appears on the display, it
indicates the disc is dirty, damaged, or it
was inserted up–side down. Clean the
disc or insert it correctly.
133
’99camry U
Dolby
B NR∗
If you are listening to a tape that was
recorded with Dolby B Noise Reduction,
push the button marked with the double–D
symbol. The double–D symbol will appear
on the display. Push the button again to
turn off Dolby B NR.
The Dolby NR mode reduces tape noise
by about 10 dB. For best sound reproduction, play your tapes with this button on
or off according to the mode used for
recording the tape.
PROG (Program)
Push ”PROG” to select the other side of
a cassette tape. The display indicates
which side is currently selected (” ” indicates top
side).
side,
”
”
indicates
bottom
Auto–reverse feature: After the cassette
player reaches the end of a tape side, it
automatically reverses and begins to play
the other side. This is true whether the
cassette was playing or fast forwarding.
∗ : Dolby noise reduction manufactured under license from
PWR⋅VOL (Power⋅Volume)
Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. ”DOLBY” and the
double D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories
Licensing Corporation.
Push ”PWR⋅VOL” to turn the audio system
on and off. Turn ”PWR⋅VOL” to adjust the
volume.
MTL (Metal) Display
If a metal or chrome equivalent cassette
tape is put in the cassette player, the
player will automatically adapt to it and
”MTL” will appear on the display.
RAND (Random)
There are two random features—you can
either listen to the tracks on all the compact discs in the magazine in random order, or only listen to the tracks on a
specific compact disc in random order.
Random playing for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”RAND”. ”RAND”
will appear on the display. The disc you
are listening to will play in random order.
If you hear a beep, you held the button
too long, and the player will play all the
tracks in the magazine in random order.
To turn off the random feature, push the
”RAND” a second time.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Random playing for all the tracks in the
magazine:
Push and hold ”RAND” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RAND” will appear on the display
and the player will perform all the tracks
on all the discs in the magazine in random order. To turn off the random feature,
push ”RAND” a second time.
RPT (Repeat)
Cassette Player
Push ”RPT” while the track is playing.
”RPT” will appear on the display. When
the track ends, it will automatically be
rewound and replayed. This process will
be continued until you push the button
again to turn off the repeat feature.
There must be at least 3 seconds of blank
space between tracks in order for the repeat feature to work correctly.
134
’99camry U
Compact Disc Player
SCAN
Compact disc player
There are two repeat features—you can
either replay a disc track or a whole compact disc.
Radio
There are two scan features—you can either scan the tracks on a specific disc or
scan the first tracks of all the discs in the
magazine.
Repeating a track:
Quickly push and release ”RPT” while the
track is playing. ”RPT” will appear on the
display. If you hear a beep, you held the
button too long, and the player will repeat
the whole disc. When the track ends, it
will automatically be replayed. This process will be continued until you push the
button again to turn off the repeat feature.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Repeating a disc:
Push and hold ”RPT” until you hear a
beep. ”D·RPT” will appear on the display.
The player will repeat all the tracks on the
disc you are listening to. When the disc
ends, the player will automatically go back
to the top track of the disc and replay.
This process will be continued until you
push the button again to turn off the repeat feature.
You can either scan all the frequencies on
a band or scan only the preset stations
for that band.
To scan the preset stations:
Push and hold ”SCAN” until you hear a
beep. The radio will tune in the next preset station up the band, stay there for a
few seconds, and then move to the next
preset station. To select a station, push
”SCAN” a second time.
To scan all the frequencies:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. If you
hear a beep, you held the button too long,
and the radio will scan the preset stations. The radio will find the next station
up the station band, stay there for a few
seconds, and then scan again. To select
a station, push ”SCAN” a second time.
Scanning for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release ”SCAN”. ”SCAN”
will appear on the display and the player
will scan all the tracks on the disc you
are listening to. If you hear a beep, you
held the button too long, and the player
will scan the first tracks of all the discs
in the magazine. To select a track, push
the ”SCAN” a second time. If the player
scanned all the tracks on the disc, it will
stop scanning.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Scanning for the first tracks of all the
discs in the magazine:
Push ”SCAN” until you hear a beep.
”D·SCAN” will appear on the display and
the player will perform the first track of
the next disc. To select a disc, push the
”SCAN” a second time. If the player has
scanned all the discs, it will stop scanning.
135
’99camry U
SEEK (Seeking)
Radio
In the seek mode, the radio finds and
plays the next station up or down the
station band.
To seek a station, push and hold the ””
or ”” side of ”TUNE” until you hear a
beep. Do this again to find another station.
Cassette Player
By using this button, you can skip up or
down to a different track.
When counting the number of tracks you
want to rewind, remember to count the
current track as well. For example, if you
want to rewind to a song that is two before the song you are listening to, push
on the down side of the button until ”REW
3” appears on the display.
If you have pushed the track button more
than you wanted to, push the other side
of the button. The track number will be
reduced.
You can skip up tp nine tracks at a time.
The track number you select is not valid
if it is higher than the number of tracks
remaining on the current cassette side.
Push the up or down side of the button.
”FF 1” or ”REW 1” will appear on the
display.
reached, the player will automatically
start playing the same side.
Next, push either side of
until the number on the
the number of tracks you
you push the button ten
feature will be turned off.
136
the track button
display reaches
want to skip. If
times, the skip
After the beginning of the tape is
After the end of the tape is reached,
the player will automatically reverse
sides and start playing the other side.
There must be at least 3 seconds of blank
space between tracks for the track button
to work correctly. In addition, the feature
may not work well with some spoken
word, live, or classical recordings.
SKIP
The skip feature allows you to fast forward past long stretches of blank tape.
This is especially useful at the end of
cassettes.
Push ”SKIP”. ”SKIP” will appear on the
display. The cassette player will keep
track of how much blank space it plays.
Any time it has played about 10 seconds
of blank tape, it will automatically fast
forward to the next track and begin to
play.
Push the button a second time to turn off
the skip feature.
ST (Stereo reception) display
Your radio automatically changes to stereo
reception when a stereo broadcast is received. ”ST” appears on the display. If the
signal becomes weak, the radio reduces
the amount of channel separation to prevent the weak signal from creating noise.
If the signal becomes extremely weak, the
radio switches from stereo to mono reception.
’99camry U
—Car audio system operating
hints
TAPE
Push ”TAPE” to switch from radio or compact disc operation to cassette operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn
on the cassette player by pushing ”TAPE”.
In both cases, a cassette must already be
loaded in the player.
TRACK
(Track
up/down
Compact disc player
button):
By using this button, you can skip up or
down to a different track.
Push either side of the track button until
the number of the track you want to listen
to appears on the display. If you want to
return to the beginning of the current
track, push the down side of the button
one time, quickly.
TUNE (Tuning)
Your Toyota has an electronic tuning radio
(ETR). Push and release the ”” (up) or
”” (down) side of ”TUNE” to step up or
down the station band. (If you hear a
beep, you held the button too long and
the radio will go into the seek mode.)
NOTICE
To ensure the correct audio system
operation:
Be careful not to spill beverages
over the audio system.
Do not put anything other than a
cassette tape or Compact Disc into
the slot.
RADIO RECEPTION
Usually, a problem with radio reception
does not mean there is a problem with
your radio—it is just the normal result of
conditions outside the vehicle.
For example, nearby buildings and terrain
can interfere with FM reception. Power
lines or telephone wires can interfere with
AM signals. And of course, radio signals
have a limited range, and the farther you
are from a station, the weaker its signal
will be. In addition, reception conditions
change constantly as your vehicle moves.
FM
Fading and drifting stations—Generally, the
effective range of FM is about 40 km (25
miles). Once outside this range, you may
notice fading and drifting, which increase
with the distance from the radio transmitter. They are often accompanied by distortion.
Multi–path—FM signals are reflective,
making it possible for two signals to reach
your antenna at the same time. If this
happens, the signals will cancel each other out, causing a momentary flutter or
loss of reception.
Static and fluttering—These occur when
signals are blocked by buildings, trees, or
other large objects. Increasing the bass
level may reduce static and fluttering.
Station swapping—If the FM signal you
are listening to is interrupted or weakened, and there is another strong station
nearby on the FM band, your radio may
tune in the second station until the original signal can be picked up again.
Here are some common reception problems that probably do not indicate a problem with your radio:
137
’99camry U
AM
Use high–quality cassettes.
Fading—AM broadcasts are reflected by
the upper atmosphere—especially at night.
These reflected signals can interfere with
those received directly from the radio station, causing the radio station to sound
alternately strong and weak.
Low–quality cassette tapes can cause
Station interference—When a reflected signal and a signal received directly from a
radio station are very nearly the same
frequency, they can interfere with each
other, making it difficult to hear the broadcast.
Do not use a cassette if it has been
Static—AM is easily affected by external
sources of electrical noise, such as high
tension power lines, lightening, or electrical motors. This results in static.
Store cassettes in their cases and out
CARING FOR YOUR CASSETTE PLAYER
AND TAPES
For high performance from your cassette
player and tapes:
Clean the tape head and other parts regularly.
A dirty tape head or tape path can
decrease sound quality and tangle your
cassette tapes. The easiest way to
clean them is by using a cleaning tape.
(A wet type is recommended.)
138
many problems, including poor sound,
inconsistent
playing
speed,
and
constant auto–reversing. They can also
get stuck or tangled in the cassette
player.
damaged or tangled or if its label is
peeling off.
Do not leave a cassette in the player
if you are not listening to it, especially
if it is hot outside.
of direct sunlight.
Avoid using cassettes with a total playing time longer than 100 minutes (50
minutes per side). The tape used in
these cassettes is thin and could get
stuck or tangled in the cassette player.
CARING FOR YOUR
PLAYER AND DISCS
COMPACT
DISC
Use only compact discs labeled as
shown.
Extremely high temperatures can keep
your compact disc player from working.
On hot days, use the air conditioning
to cool the vehicle interior before you
listen to a disc.
Bumpy roads or other vibrations may
make your compact disc player skip.
’99camry U
If moisture gets into your compact disc
CAUTION
player, you may not hear any sound
even though your compact disc player
appears to be working. Remove the
disc from the player and wait until it
dries.
Compact disc players use invisible laser beam which could cause hazardous radiation exposure if directed
outside the unit. Be sure to operate
the player correctly as instructed.
Handle compact discs carefully, especially when you are inserting them.
Hold them on the edge and do not
bend them. Avoid getting fingerprints
on them, particularly on the shiny side.
Dirt, scrapes, warping, pin holes, or
other disc damage could cause the
player to skip or to repeat a section of
a track. (To see a pin hole, hold the
disc up to the light.)
Remove discs from the compact disc
player when you are not listening
to them. Store them in their plastic
cases away from moisture, heat, and
direct sunlight.
To clean a compact disc: Wipe it with a
soft, lint–free cloth that has been dampened with water. Wipe in a straight line
from the center to the edge of the disc
(not in circles). Dry it with another soft,
lint–free cloth. Do not use a conventional
record cleaner or anti–static device.
A new disc may have rough edges on
its inner and outer perimeter. Remove
the rough edges by pressing the side
of a ball–point pen or pencil against
the inner and outer perimeter of the
disc as shown.
If you continue to play a disc with rough
edges, flakes will fall on to the signal side
of the disc and cause sound skipping or
other problems.
139
’99camry U
Air conditioning system—
—Controls
1. ”A/C” Button
2. Air Intake Selector
3. Air Flow Selector
4. Temperature Selector
5. Fan Speed Selector
140
’99camry U
Fan speed selector
For details about air flow selector settings,
see the illustration after ”A/C” button.
Turn the knob to adjust the fan speed—to
the right to increase, to the left to decrease.
Turning the Air Flow Selector to windshield position turns on the defroster to
clear the front view more quickly.
Temperature selector
Turn the knob to adjust the temperature—
to the right to warm, to the left to cool.
Air flow selector
Turn the knob to select the vents used for
air flow.
1. Panel—Air flows mainly
instrument panel vents.
from
the
2. Bi–level—Air flows from both the floor
vents and the instrument panel vents.
3. Floor—Air flows mainly from the floor
vents.
4. Floor/Windshield—Air
flows
mainly
from the floor vents and windshield
vents.
5. Windshield—Air flows mainly from the
windshield vents.
141
’99camry U
”A/C” button
To turn on the air conditioning, press the
”A/C” button. The ”A/C” button indicator
will come on. To turn the air conditioning
off, press the button again.
If the ”A/C” button indicator flashes, there
is a problem in the air conditioning system
and the air conditioning automatically
shuts off. If this happens, take your vehicle to a Toyota dealer for service.
Air intake selector
Move the lever to select the air source.
1. Recirculate—Recirculates the air inside
the vehicle.
2. Fresh—Draws outside air into the system.
142
’99camry U
—Air flow selector settings
—Operating tips
To cool off your Toyota after it has
been parked in the hot sun, drive with
the windows open for a few minutes.
This vents the hot air, allowing the air
conditioning to cool the interior more
quickly.
Make sure the air intake grilles in front
of the windshield are not blocked (by
leaves or snow, for example).
On humid days, do not blow cold air
on the windshield. The windshield could
fog up because of the difference in air
temperature on the inside and outside
of the windshield.
Keep the area under the front seats
clear to allow air to circulate throughout the vehicle.
On cold days, move the fan speed to
”HI” for a minute to help clear the intake ducts of snow or moisture. This
can reduce the amount of fogging on
the windows.
143
’99camry U
Heating
Air conditioning
Defogging
For best results, set controls to:
For best results, set controls to:
The inside of the windshield
Fan speed—Any setting except ”OFF”
Temperature—Towards WARM
(red zone)
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—FLOOR
Air conditioning—OFF
Fan speed—Any setting except ”OFF”
Temperature—Towards COLD
(blue zone)
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—PANEL
Air conditioning—ON
For quick heating, select recirculated
For quick cooling, move the air intake
air for a few minutes. To keep the
windows from fogging, select fresh after the vehicle interior has been
warmed.
selector to recirculate for a few minutes.
Press the ”A/C” button on for dehumidified heating.
Choose floor/windshield air flow to heat
the vehicle interior while defrosting or
defogging the windshield.
144
Ventilation
For best results, set controls to:
Fan speed—Any setting except ”OFF”
Temperature—Towards COLD
(blue zone)
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—PANEL
Air conditioning—OFF
For best results, set controls to:
Fan speed—Any setting except ”OFF”
Temperature—Towards WARM
(red zone) to heat;
COLD (blue zone) to
cool
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—WINDSHIELD
Turning the Air Flow Selector to windshield position turns on the defroster to
clear the front view more quickly.
Press the ”A/C” button for dehumidified
heating or cooling. This setting clears the
front view more quickly.
On humid days, do not blow cold air
on the windshield—the difference between the outside and inside temperatures could make the fogging worse.
’99camry U
—Side vents
Defrosting
The outside of the windshield
For best results, set controls to:
Fan speed—Any setting except ”OFF”
Temperature—Towards WARM
(red zone)
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—WINDSHIELD
Turning the Air Flow Selector to windshield position turns on the defroster to
clear the front view more quickly.
Press the ”A/C” button for dehumidified
heating. This setting clears the front view
more quickly.
To heat the vehicle interior while defrosting
the
windshield,
floor/windshield air flow.
If air flow control is not satisfactory, check
the side vents. The side vents may be
opened or closed as shown.
choose
145
’99camry U
146
’99camry U
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Clock
The digital clock indicates the time.
The key must be in the ”ACC” or ”ON”
position.
To reset the hour: Push the ”H” button.
To reset the minutes: Push the ”M” button.
If the electrical power source has been
disconnected from the clock, the time display will automatically be set to 1:00 (one
o’clock).
Chapter 1–8
Other equipment
When the instrument panel lights are
turned on, the brightness of the time indication will be reduced.
Clock
Cigarette lighter and ashtrays
Power outlet
Type A
Type B only—
If quick adjustment to a full hour is desired, push the ”:00” button.
Glove box
Garage door opener box
For example, if the ”:00” button is depressed when the time is between
1:01—1:29, the time will change to 1:00.
If the time is between 1:30—1:59, the
time will change to 2:00.
Miscellaneous box
Auxiliary box
Cup holder
Traction control system
Floor mat
Type B
147
’99camry U
Cigarette lighter and ashtrays
Power outlet
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
To use the cigarette lighter, press it in.
When it becomes heated, it automatically pops out ready for use.
If the engine is not running, the key must
be in the ”ACC” position.
Do not hold the cigarette lighter pressed
in.
Use a Toyota genuine cigarette lighter or
equivalent for replacement.
ASHTRAYS
Cigarette lighter and front ashtray
To use the ashtray, open out.
When finished with your cigarette, thoroughly extinguish it in the ashtray to prevent other cigarette butts from catching
fire. After using the ashtray, push it back
in completely.
To remove the ashtray, press down on the
lock spring plate and pull out.
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in
case of an accident or sudden stop
while driving, always push the ashtray back in completely after use.
Rear ashtray (on some models )
148
The power outlet is designed for power
supply for car accessories.
The key must be in the ”ACC” or ”ON”
position for the power outlet to be used.
NOTICE
To prevent the fuse from being
blown, do not use the electricity
over the total vehicle capacity of
12V/120W.
To prevent the battery from being
discharged, do not use the power
outlet longer than necessary when
the engine is not running.
’99camry U
Glove box
Garage door opener box
To use the glove box, do this.
The box is designed to store a garage
door opener transmitter.
Close the power outlet lid when the
power outlet is not in use. Inserting
a foreign object other than the appropriate plug that fits the outlet,
or allowing any liquid into the outlet may cause electrical failure or
short circuits.
To open: Pull the lever.
With the instrument panel lights on, the
glove box light will come on when the
glove box is open.
Open the cover and remove the Velcro
loop.
To lock: Insert the master key and turn it
clockwise.
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in
case of an accident or a sudden stop,
always keep the glove box door
closed while driving.
149
’99camry U
Remove the paper strip covering the adhesive on back side of loop and adhere loop
to back side of the transmitter near center.
150
Please note if transmitter has wire clip for
sun visor, this clip must be removed prior
to adhesion of the Velcro.
Place the transmitter with Velcro loop facing inside of box into the box. Make sure
the transmitter button is located above
button pins.
’99camry U
Remove spacers from the center panel.
Place the largest spacer on the pin that
would be below transmitter button when
the cover is closed. Close the cover.
When the garage door opener transmitter
is properly installed, you can operate the
transmitter by pushing the center panel of
the cover.
If the center panel does not contact with
your garage door opener transmitter:
Check to see if spacer is on correct
pin.
Attach another spacer to the top of
original spacer. Check operation. If required, continue add spacers until contact is achieved.
If the transmitter is clattering during driving, fill in a piece of felt or pad to prevent
the transmitter from clattering.
151
’99camry U
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in
case of an accident or a sudden
stop, always keep the garage door
opener box closed while driving.
Keep the remained spacers away
from children.
The miscellaneous box and garage door
opener box (stored in the glove box)
are interchangeable.
Removing the cover—
Half open the cover. Pinch each hinge and
pull it out of its pivot one by one as
shown above.
Do not remove the cover forcibly.
152
Installing the cover—
Align the hinges to the pivots, and press
each hinge with a thumb until you hear a
click.
Make sure that
closes smoothly.
the
cover
opens and
’99camry U
Miscellaneous box
Auxiliary box
To use the box, open it as shown
above.
To use the box, pull on the handle.
Cup holder
Front
CAUTION
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in
case of an accident or a sudden stop,
always keep the miscellaneous box
closed while driving.
To reduce the chance of injury in
case of an accident or a sudden stop,
always keep the auxiliary box closed
while driving.
NOTICE
In hot weather, inside of the vehicle
becomes very hot. Do not leave anything flammable or deformable such
as a lighter, the glasses, etc. inside.
Rear
153
’99camry U
Traction control system
The cup holder is designed for holding
cups or drink–cans securely in its
holes.
AUTOMATIC TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM
Front: To use the holder, open the lid.
Rear: To use the holder, pull it out.
CAUTION
Do not place anything else other
than cups or drink–cans on the cup
holder, as such item may be thrown
about in the compartment and possibly injure people in the vehicle
during sudden braking or an accident.
Slip indicator light
Leave the system on during ordinary
driving so that it can operate when
needed. When traction control is applied, the slip indicator light blinks.
To reduce the chance of injury in
case of an accident or sudden stop
while driving, keep the cup holder
closed when it is not in use.
”TRAC OFF” indicator/warning light
154
The traction control system automatically helps control the spinning of the
front wheels which may occur when accelerating on slippery road surfaces,
thus assisting driver to control the driving power of the front wheels. When
you turn the ignition switch on, the
traction control system always turns on
automatically, and the slip indicator
light and ”TRAC OFF” indicator/warning
light will come on. The indicator lights
will go off after about 3 seconds.
You may hear a sound in the engine
compartment for a few seconds when the
engine is started or just after the vehicle
is started. This means that the traction
control system is in the self–check mode,
and does not indicate malfunction. When
the traction control system is operating,
you may feel vibration or noise of your
vehicle, caused by operation of the
brakes. This indicates the system is functioning properly.
’99camry U
When getting the vehicle out of mud or
new snow, etc. the traction control system
will help operate to prevent the wheels
from spinning.
CAUTION
MANUAL OPERATION
You can turn off the traction control
system by pushing the ”TRAC OFF”
switch. The ”TRAC OFF” indicator/warning light will come on. Pushing the
”TRAC OFF” switch a second time
turns on the traction control system
and the ”TRAC OFF” indicator/warning
light will go off.
Under certain slippery road conditions, full traction of the vehicles and
power to the front wheels may not be
maintained, even though the traction
control system is in operation. Do not
drive the vehicle at any speed or conduct any during maneuver which will
cause the vehicle to lose traction. In
situations where the road surface is
covered with ice or snow, your vehicle should be fitted with snow tires
or tire chains. Always drive at an appropriate and cautious speed for the
road conditions present.
155
’99camry U
Floor mat
Use a floor mat of the correct size.
If the floor carpet and floor
hole, then it is designed for
locking clip. Fix the floor mat
clip into the hole in the floor
156
mat have a
use with a
with locking
carpet.
CAUTION
Make sure the floor mat is properly
placed on the floor carpet. If the floor
mat slips and interferes with the
movement of the pedals during driving, it may cause an accident.
’99camry U
Part 7
DO–IT–YOURSELF
MAINTENANCE—
Chapter 7–1
Introduction
Engine compartment overview
Fuse locations
Do–it–yourself service
precautions
Parts and tools
209
’99camry U
Engine compartment overview
5S–FE engine
1. Power steering fluid reservoir
2. Engine coolant reservoir
3. Engine oil filler cap
4. Engine oil level dipstick
5. Brake fluid reservoir
6. Fuse blocks
7. Battery
8. Electric cooling fans
9. Windshield washer fluid tank
210
’99camry U
1MZ–FE engine
1. Power steering fluid reservoir
2. Engine coolant reservoir
3. Engine oil level dipstick
4. Engine oil filler cap
5. Brake fluid reservoir
6. Fuse blocks
7. Battery
8. Electric cooling fans
9. Windshield washer fluid tank
211
’99camry U
Fuse locations
Spare fuses
Type A
With daytime running light system only
212
Type B
’99camry U
Do–it–yourself service
precautions
If you perform maintenance by yourself,
be sure to follow the correct procedure
given in this part.
You should be aware that improper or incomplete servicing may result in operating
problems.
Performing
do–it–yourself
maintenance
during the warranty period may affect your
warranty coverage. Read the separate
Toyota Warranty statement for details and
suggestions.
CAUTION
When the engine is running, keep
hands, clothing, and tools away
from the moving fan and engine
drive
belts.
(Removing
rings,
watches, and ties is advisable.)
Right
after driving, the engine
compartment—the engine, radiator,
exhaust manifold and spark plug
boots, etc.—will be hot. So be careful not to touch them. Oil, fluids
and spark plugs may also be hot.
This part gives instructions only for those
items that are relatively easy for an owner
to perform. As explained in Part 6, there
are still a number of items that must be
done by a qualified technician with special
tools.
If the engine is hot, do not remove
For information on tools and parts for do–
it–yourself maintenance, see ”Parts and
tools”.
low open flames around fuel or the
battery. Their fumes are flammable.
Utmost care
ing on your
injury. Here
you should
serve:
should be taken when workvehicle to prevent accidental
are a few precautions that
be especially careful to ob-
the radiator cap or loosen the drain
plugs to prevent burning yourself.
Do not smoke, cause sparks or al Be extremely cautious when working on the battery. It contains poisonous and corrosive sulfuric acid.
Do not get under your vehicle with
just the body jack supporting it. Always use automotive jack stands or
other solid supports.
213
’99camry U
Be sure that the ignition is off if
Dispose of used oil and filter only
you work near the electric cooling
fans or radiator grille. With the
ignition on, the electric cooling fans
will automatically start to run if the
engine coolant temperature is high
and/or the air conditioning is on.
in a safe and acceptable manner.
Do not dispose of used oil and filter in household trash, in sewers or
onto the ground. Call your dealer or
a service station for information
concerning recycling or disposal.
Use eye protection whenever you
work on or under your vehicle
where you may be exposed to flying
or falling material, fluid spray, etc.
Used engine oil contains potentially
harmful contaminants which may
cause skin disorders such as inflammation or skin cancer, so care
should be taken to avoid prolonged
and repeated contact with it. To remove used engine oil from your
skin, wash thoroughly with soap
and water.
Do not leave used oil within the
reach of children.
NOTICE
Remember that battery and ignition
cables carry high currents or voltages. Be careful of accidentally
causing a short circuit.
Add only demineralized or distilled
water to fill the radiator. And if you
spill some of the coolant, be sure
to wash off with water to prevent it
from damaging the parts or paint.
Do not allow dirt or anything else
to fall through the spark plugholes.
Use only spark plugs of the specified type. Using other types will
cause engine damage, loss of performance or radio noise.
Do not reuse platinum–tipped spark
plugs by cleaning or regapping.
214
Do not overfill automatic transmission fluid, or the transmission
could be damaged.
Do not drive with the air cleaner
filter removed, or excessive engine
wear could result. Also backfiring
could cause a fire in the engine
compartment.
Be careful not to scratch the glass
surface with the wiper frame.
When closing the engine hood,
check to see that you have not forgotten any tools, rags, etc.
’99camry U
Parts and tools
Here is a list of parts and tools you will
need on performing do–it–yourself maintenance. Remember all Toyota parts are designed in metric sizes, so your tools must
be metric.
Checking the engine oil level
Parts (if level is low):
Engine oil API grade SJ, ”Energy–Conserving” or ILSAC multigrade having
viscosity proper for your climate
Tools:
Rag or paper towel
Funnel (only for adding oil)
Checking the engine coolant level
Parts (if level is low):
”Toyota Long Life Coolant” or equivalent
See Chapter 7–2 for details about coolant type selection.
Demineralized or distilled water
Tools:
Funnel (only for adding coolant)
Checking brake fluid
Checking and replacing fuses
Parts (if level is low):
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3
brake fluid
Parts (if replacement is necessary):
Genuine Toyota fuse or equivalent with
same amperage rating as original
Tools:
Rag or paper towel
Funnel (only for adding fluid)
Adding washer fluid
Parts:
Water
Washer fluid containing antifreeze (for
winter use)
Checking power steering fluid
Parts (if level is low):
Automatic
transmission
DEXRONII or III
fluid
Tools:
Rag or paper towel
Funnel (only for adding fluid)
Replacing light bulbs
Parts:
Bulb with same number and wattage
rating as original (See charts in ”Replacing light bulbs” in Chapter 7–3.)
Checking battery condition
Tools:
Warm water
Baking soda
Grease
Conventional
clamp bolts)
Tools:
Funnel
Tools:
Screwdriver
wrench
(for
terminal
Flat–bladed screwdriver
215
’99camry U
216
’99camry U
Part 7
DO–IT–YOURSELF
MAINTENANCE—
Checking the engine oil level
Low level
Full level
CAUTION
Type A
Chapter 7–2
Engine and Chassis
Type B
Checking the engine oil level
Checking the engine coolant
level
Checking brake fluid
Checking power steering fluid
Checking tire pressure
Checking and replacing tires
Rotating tires
Installing snow tires and chains
Replacing wheels
Aluminum wheel precautions
Add oil
O.K.
Too full
With the engine at operating temperature and turned off, check the oil level
on the dipstick.
1. To get a true reading, the vehicle
should be on a level spot. After turning
off the engine, wait a few minutes for
the oil to drain back into the bottom of
the engine.
2. Pull out the dipstick, and wipe it clean
with a rag.
Be careful not to touch the hot exhaust manifold.
If the oil level is below or only slightly
above the low level line, add engine oil
of the same type as already in the engine.
Remove the oil filler cap and add engine
oil in small quantities at a time, checking
the dipstick.
The approximate quantity of oil needed to
fill between the low level and the full level
on the dipstick is indicated below for reference.
When the level reaches within the correct
range, install the filler cap hand–tight.
Oil quantity, L (qt., lmp. qt.):
5S–FE engine
0.7 (0.7, 0.6)
1MZ–FE engine
1.5 (1.6, 1.3)
NOTICE
3. Reinsert the dipstick—push it in as far
as it will go, or the reading will not be
correct.
Avoid overfilling, or
could be damaged.
4. Pull the dipstick out and look at the oil
level on the end.
Check the oil level on the dipstick
once again after adding the oil.
the
engine
217
’99camry U
Engine oil selection
Oil identification marks
Use API grade SJ, ”Energy–Conserving”
or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Either or both API registered marks are
added to some oil containers to help
you select the oil you should use.
Recommended viscosity (SAE):
The API Service Symbol is located anywhere on the outside of the container.
API service symbol
The ILSAC (International Lubricant Standardization and Approval Committee) Certification Mark is displayed on the front of
the container.
SAE 5W–30 is the best choice for your
vehicle, for good fuel economy, and
good starting in cold weather.
If you use SAE 10W–30 engine oil in
extremely low temperatures, the engine
may become difficult to start, so SAE
5W–30engine oil is recommended.
ILSAC certification mark
218
The top portion of the label shows the oil
quality by API (American Petroleum Institute) designations such as SJ. The center
portion of the label shows the SAE viscosity grade such as SAE 5W–30. ”Energy–
Conserving” shown in the lower portion,
indicates that the oil has fuel–saving capabilities.
’99camry U
Checking the engine coolant
level
Look at the see–through coolant reservoir when the engine is cold. The coolant level is satisfactory if it is between
the ”FULL” and ”LOW” lines on the
reservoir. If the level is low, add ethylene–glycol type coolant for a proper
corrosion protection of aluminum components.
The coolant level in the reservoir will vary
with engine temperature. However, if the
level is on or below the ”LOW” line, add
coolant. Bring the level up to the ”FULL”
line.
Always use ethylene–glycol type coolant
for a proper corrosion protection of aluminum components. See information in the
next column.
If the coolant level drops within a short
time after replenishing, there may be a
leak in the system. Visually check the
radiator, hoses, engine coolant filler cap,
radiator cap and drain cock and water
pump.
If you can find no leak, have your Toyota
dealer test the cap pressure and check
for leaks in the cooling system.
CAUTION
To prevent burning yourself, do not
remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot.
Coolant type selection
Use of improper coolants may damage
your engine cooling system. Your coolant
must contain ethylene–glycol type coolant
for a proper corrosion protection of your
engine
that
contains
aluminum
components. Use ”Toyota Long Life
Coolant” or equivalent.
We recommend to use 50% solution for
your Toyota, to provide protection down to
about –35C (–31F). When it is extremely cold, to provide protection down to
about –50°C (–58°F), 60% solution is recommended. Do not use more than 70%
solution for better coolant performance.
NOTICE
Do not use alcohol type antifreeze or
plain water alone.
In addition to preventing freezing and
subsequent damage to the engine, this
type of coolant will also prevent corrosion.
Further supplemental inhibitors or additives
are neither needed nor recommended.
Read the coolant container for information
on freeze protection. Follow the manufacturer’s directions for how much to mix
with plain water (preferably demineralized
water or distilled water). The total capacity
of the cooling system is given in Part 8.
219
’99camry U
Checking brake fluid
Checking power steering fluid
Use only newly opened brake fluid. Once
opened, brake fluid absorbs moisture from
the air, and excess moisture can cause a
dangerous loss of braking.
CAUTION
Take care when filling the reservoir
because brake fluid can harm your
eyes and damage painted surfaces. If
fluid gets in your eyes, flush your
eyes with clean water.
To check the fluid level, simply look at
the see–through reservoir. The level
should be between the ”MAX” and
”MIN” lines on the reservoir.
It is normal for the brake fluid level to go
down slightly as the brake pads wear. So
be sure to keep the reservoir filled.
If the reservoir needs frequent refilling, it
may indicate a serious mechanical problem.
If the level is low, add SAE J1703 or
FMVSS No.116 DOT 3 brake fluid to the
brake reservoir.
Remove and replace the reservoir cover
by hand.
220
NOTICE
If you spill some of the fluid, be sure
to wash it off with water to prevent
it from damaging the parts or paint.
Open
If hot
O.K.
Close
If cold
O.K.
If cold
add
If hot
add
Check the fluid level through the reservoir. If necessary, add automatic transmission fluid DEXRONII or III.
If the vehicle has been driven around 80
km/h (50 mph) for 20 minutes (a little
more in frigid temperatures), the fluid is
hot (60C—80C or 140F—175F). You
may also check the level when the fluid
is
cold
(about
room
temperature,
10C—30C or 50F—85F) if the engine
has not been run for about five hours.
’99camry U
Checking tire pressure
Clean all dirt from outside of the reservoir
tank and look at the fluid level. If the fluid
is cold, the level should be in the ”COLD”
range. Similarly, if it is hot, the fluid level
should be in the ”HOT” range. If the level
is at the low side of either range, add
automatic transmission fluid DEXRONII
or III to bring the level within the range.
Low tire pressure results in excessive
wear, poor handling, reduced fuel economy, and the possibility of blowouts from
overheated tires. Also, low tire pressure
can cause poor sealing of the tire bead.
If the tire pressure is excessively low,
there is the possibility of wheel deformation and/or tire separation.
To remove the filler cap, turn it counterclockwise and lift up. To reinstall it, turn
it clockwise. After replacing the filler
cap,visually check the steering box case,
vane pump and hose connections for
leaks or damage.
High tire pressure produces a harsh ride,
handling problems,excessive wear at the
center of the tire tread, and a greater
possibility of tire damage from road hazards.
CAUTION
The reservoir tank may be hot so be
careful not to burn yourself.
NOTICE
Avoid overfilling, or the power steering could be damaged.
Keep your tire pressures at the proper
level.
The recommended cold tire pressures, tire
size and the vehicle capacity weight are
given in Part 8. They are also on the tire
pressure label as shown.
You should check the tire pressures every
two weeks, or at least once a month. And
don’t forget the spare!
Incorrect tire pressure can reduce tire
life and make your vehicle less safe to
drive.
If a tire frequently needs refilling, have it
checked by your Toyota dealer.
The following instructions for checking
tire pressure should be observed:
The pressure should be checked only
when the tires are cold. If your vehicle has been parked for at least 3
hours and has not been driven for
more than 1.5 km or 1 mile since, you
will get an accurate cold tire pressure
reading.
Always use a tire pressure gauge.
The appearance of a tire can be misleading. Besides, tire pressures that
are even just a few pounds off can
degrade handling and ride.
221
’99camry U
Checking and replacing tires
Take special care when adding air to
the compact spare tire. The smaller
tire size can gain pressure very quickly. Add compressed air in small quantities and check the pressure often until
it reaches the specified pressure.
Tread wear indicator
Even if the damage does not appear serious, a qualified technician should examine
the damage. Objects which have penetrated the tire may have caused internal
damage.
Do not bleed or reduce tire pressure
after driving. It is normal for the tire
pressure to be higher after driving.
Never exceed the vehicle capacity
Any tires which are over six years old
must be checked by a qualified technician even if damage is not obvious.
weight. The passenger and luggage
weight should be located so that the
vehicle is balanced.
Be sure to reinstall the tire inflation
valve caps. Without the valve caps,
dirt or moisture could get into the valve
core and cause air leakage. If the caps
have been lost, have new ones put on
as soon as possible.
CHECKING YOUR TIRES
Check the tires tread for the tread wear
indicators. If the indicators show, replace the tires.
The tires on your Toyota have built–in
tread wear indicators to help you know
when the tires need replacement. When
the tread depth wears to 1.6 mm (0.06
in.) or less, the indicators will appear. If
you can see the indicators in two or more
adjacent grooves, the tire should be replaced. The lower the tread, the higher
the risk of skidding.
The effectiveness of snow tires is lost
if the tread wears down below 4 mm
(0.16 in.).
222
Check the tires regularly for damage
such as cuts, splits and cracks. If any
damage is found, consult with a technician and have the tire repaired or replaced.
Tires deteriorate with age even if they
have never or seldom been used.
This applies also to the spare tire and
tires stored for future use.
REPLACING YOUR TIRES
When replacing a tire, use only the
same size and construction as originally installed and with the same or greater load capacity.
Using any other size or type of tire may
seriously affect handling, ride, speedometer/odometer calibration, ground clearance,
and clearance between the body and tires
or snow chains.
’99camry U
Rotating tires
WHEN TO
CHAINS
CAUTION
bias–ply tires on your vehicle. It
can cause dangerous handling characteristics, resulting in loss of control.
When a tire is replaced, the wheel
should always be balanced.
An unbalanced wheel may affect vehicle
handling and tire life. Wheels can get out
of balance with regular use and should
therefore be balanced occasionally.
When replacing a tubeless tire, the air
valve should also be replaced with a
new one.
TIRES
OR
SNOW TIRE SELECTION
If you need snow tires, select the same
size, construction and load capacity as
the original tires on your Toyota.
recom-
See ”If you have a flat tire” in Part 4 for
tire change procedure.
SNOW
On wet or dry roads, conventional tires
provide better traction than snow tires.
Do not use tires or wheels other
Toyota recommends all four tires, or at
least both of the front or rear tires be
replaced at a time as a set.
USE
Snow tires or chains are recommended
when driving on snow or ice.
Do not mix radial, bias belted, or
than the manufacturer’s
mended size.
Installing snow tires and
chains
To equalize the wear and help extend
tire life, Toyota recommends that you
rotate your tires approximately every
12000 km (7500 miles). However, the
most appropriate timing for tire rotation
may vary according to your driving habits and road surface conditions.
See ”If you have a flat tire” in Part 4 for
tire change procedure.
When rotating tires, check for uneven
wear and damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused by incorrect tire pressure, improper wheel alignment, out–of–balance
wheels, or severe braking.
Do not use tires other than those mentioned above. Do not install studded tires
without first checking local regulations for
possible restrictions.
SNOW TIRE INSTALLATION
Snow tires should be installed on all
wheels.
Installing snow tires on the front wheels
only can lead to an excessive difference
in road grip capability between the front
and rear tires which could cause loss of
vehicle control.
When storing removed tires you should
store them in a cool dry place. Mark the
direction of rotation and be sure to install
them in the same direction when replacing.
223
’99camry U
Replacing wheels
CAUTION
Do not drive with the snow tires
If wheel covers are used, they will be
scratched by the chain band,so remove
the covers before putting on the chains.
incorrectly inflated.
Never drive over 120 km/h (75 mph)
with any type of snow tires.
TIRE CHAIN SELECTION
CAUTION
Do not exceed 50 km/h (30 mph) or
the chain manufacturer’s recommended speed limit, whichever is
lower.
Use the tire chains of correct size and
type.
Drive
Use SAE Class ”S” type radial tire chains
except radial cable chains or V–bar type
chains.
Avoid sharp turns or locked–wheel
Regulations regarding the use of tire
chains vary according to location or
type of road, so always check them
before installing chains.
CHAIN INSTALLATION
Install the chains on the front tires as
tightly as possible. Do not use tire
chains on the rear tires. Retighten
chains
after
driving
0.5—1.0
km
(1/4—1/2 mile).
When installing chains on your tires, carefully follow the instructions of the chain
manufacturer.
224
carefully avoiding bumps,
holes, and sharp turns, which may
cause the vehicle to bounce.
braking, as use of chains may adversely affect vehicle handling.
WHEN TO REPLACE YOUR WHEELS
If you have wheel damage such as
bending, cracks or heavy corrosion, the
wheel should be replaced.
If you fail to replace damaged wheels, the
tire may slip off the wheel or they may
cause loss of handling control.
WHEEL SELECTION
When replacing wheels, care should be
taken to ensure that the wheels are replaced by ones with the same load capacity, diameter, rim width, and offset.
This must be observed on compact spare
tires, too.
Correct replacement wheels are available
at your Toyota dealer.
A wheel of a different size or type may
adversely affect handling, wheel and bearing life, brake cooling, speedometer/odometer calibration, stopping ability, headlight
aim, bumper height, vehicle ground clearance, and tire or snow chain clearance to
the body and chassis.
’99camry U
Replacement with used wheels is not recommended as they may have been subjected to rough treatment or high mileage
and could fail without warning. Also, bent
wheels which have been straightened may
have structural damage and therefore
should not be used. Never use an inner
tube in a leaking wheel which is designed
for a tubeless tire.
Aluminum wheel precautions
After driving your vehicle the first 1600
km (1000 miles), check that the wheel
nuts are tight.
If
you have
changed your
wheel nuts are
1600 km (1000
rotated, repaired, or
tires, check that the
still tight after driving
miles).
When using tire chains, be careful not
to damage the aluminum wheels.
Use only the Toyota wheel nuts and
wrench designed for
wheels.
your
aluminum
When balancing your wheels, use only
Toyota balance weights or equivalent
and a plastic or rubber hammer.
As with any wheel, periodically check
your aluminum wheels for damage. If
damaged, replace immediately.
225
’99camry U
226
’99camry U
Part 7
DO–IT–YOURSELF
MAINTENANCE—
Chapter 7–3
Electrical components
Checking battery condition
Battery recharging precautions
Checking battery condition—
—Precautions
CAUTION
If electrolyte gets on your skin,
BATTERY PRECAUTIONS
thoroughly wash the contact area. If
you feel pain or burning, get medical attention immediately.
The battery produces flammable and
explosive hydrogen gas.
Do not cause a spark from the battery with tools.
Do not smoke or light a match near
the battery.
Checking and replacing fuses
The electrolyte contains poisonous
and corrosive sulfuric acid.
Adding washer fluid
Avoid contact with eyes, skin or
Replacing light bulbs
clothes.
Never ingest electrolyte.
Wear protective safety glasses when
If electrolyte gets on your clothes,
there is a
through to
ly take off
follow the
essary.
possibility of its soaking
your skin, so immediatethe exposed clothing and
procedure above, if nec-
If you happen to swallow electrolyte, drink a large quantity of water
or milk. Follow with milk of magnesia, beaten raw egg or vegetable
oil. Then go immediately for emergency help.
working near the battery.
Keep children away from the battery.
EMERGENCY MEASURES
If electrolyte gets in your eyes,
flush your eyes with clean water
immediately and get immediate
medical attention. If possible, continue to apply water with a sponge
or cloth while en route to the medical office.
227
’99camry U
—Checking battery exterior
Terminals
Ground cable
—Checking battery fluid
NOTICE
Be sure the engine and all accessories are off before performing maintenance.
When checking the battery, remove
the ground cable from the negative
terminal (”–” mark) first and reinstall it last.
Type A
Green
Dark
Type B
Blue
White
Clear or light
yellow
Red
Be careful not to cause a short circuit with tools.
Hold–down clamp
Check the battery for corroded or loose
terminal connections, cracks, or loose
hold–down clamp.
a. If the battery is corroded, wash it off
with a solution of warm water and baking soda. Coat the outside of the terminals with grease to prevent further corrosion.
b. If the terminal connections are loose,
tighten their clamp nuts—but do not
overtighten.
c. Tighten the hold–down clamp only
enough to keep the battery firmly in
place. Overtightening may damage the
battery case.
228
Take care no solution gets into the
battery when washing it.
CHECKING BY THE HYDROMETER
Check the battery
hydrometer color.
Hydrometer color
condition
by
the
Condition
Type A
Type B
GREEN
BLUE
Good
DARK
WHITE
Charging necessary.
Have battery checked
by your Toyota dealer.
CLEAR or
LIGHT
YELLOW
RED
Have battery
checked by your
Toyota dealer.
’99camry U
Battery recharging precautions
Checking and replacing fuses
During recharging, the battery is producing hydrogen gas.
Therefore, before recharging:
Type A
1. If recharging with the battery installed
on the vehicle, be sure to disconnect
the ground cable.
2. Be sure the power switch on the recharger is off when connecting the
charger cables to the battery and when
disconnecting them.
CAUTION
Good
Blown
Type B
Always charge the battery in an unconfined area. Do not charge the
battery in a garage or closed room
where there is not sufficient ventilation.
Only do a slow charge (5 A or
less). Charging at a quicker rate is
dangerous. The battery may explode, causing personal injuries.
If the headlights or other electrical
components do not work, check the
fuses. If any of the fuses are blown,
they must be replaced.
Good
Blown
Type C
Turn the ignition switch and inoperative
component off. Pull a suspected fuse
straight out and check it.
NOTICE
Never recharge the battery while the
engine is running. Also, be sure all
accessories are turned off.
Good
See ”Fuse locations” in Chapter 7–1 for
locations of the fuses.
Blown
Determine which fuse may be causing the
problem. The lid of the fuse box shows
the name of the circuit for each fuse. See
Part 8 of this manual for the functions
controlled by each circuit.
229
’99camry U
Adding washer fluid
Type A fuses can be pulled out by the
pull–out tool. The location of the pull–out
tool is shown in the illustration.
If you are not sure whether the fuse has
blown, try replacing the suspected fuse
with one that you know is good.
If the fuse has blown, push a new fuse
into the clip.
Only install a fuse with the amperage rating designated on the fuse box lid.
If you do not have a spare fuse, in an
emergency
you
can
pull
out
the
”MIRROR–HEATER”, ”DOME” or ”A/C”
fuse, which may be dispensable for
normal driving, and use it if its amperage
rating is the same.
If you cannot use one of the same amperage, use one that is lower,but as close as
possible to, the rating. If the amperage is
lower than that specified, the fuse might
blow out again but this does not indicate
anything wrong. Be sure to get the correct
fuse as soon as possible and return the
substitute to its original clip.
It is a good idea to purchase a set of
spare fuses and keep them in your vehicle for emergencies.
230
If the new fuse immediately blows out,
there is a problem with the electrical system. Have your Toyota dealer correct it as
soon as possible.
CAUTION
Never use a fuse with a higher amperage rating, or any other object, in
place of a fuse. This may cause extensive damage and possibly a fire.
If any washer does not work or low
windshield washer fluid level warning
light comes on, the washer tank may be
empty. Add washer fluid.
You may use plain water as washer fluid.
However, in cold areas where temperatures range below freezing point, use
washer fluid containing antifreeze. This
product is available at your Toyota dealer
and most auto parts stores. Follow the
manufacturer’s directions for how much to
mix with water.
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or any
other substitute because it may damage your vehicle’s paint.
’99camry U
Replacing light bulbs—
The following illustrations show how to
gain access to the bulbs. When replacing
a bulb, make sure the ignition switch and
light switch are off. Use bulbs with the
wattage ratings given in the table.
CAUTION
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas
inside and require special handling.
They can burst or shatter if scratched
or dropped. Hold a bulb only by its
plastic or metal case. Do not touch
the glass part of a bulb with bare
hands.
NOTICE
Only use a bulb of the listed type.
Light bulbs
Headlights
Bulb
No.
W
Type
HB2
60/55
A
Parking, front side
marker and front
turn signal lights
—
27/8
B
Rear side marker
lights
194
3.8
C
Rear turn signal
lights
3156
27
C
Stop and tail lights
3157
27/8
C
Tail light
904
9.3
C
Back–up lights
921
18
C
—
5
C
High mounted
stoplight
21CP
18
C
Personal light
—
10
B
Interior light
—
10
D
Vanity lights
—
3
D
Glove box light
—
1.2
C
Trunk light
—
3.8
C
License plate lights
A:
B:
C:
D:
HB2 halogen bulbs
Single end bulbs
Wedge base bulbs
Double end bulbs
231
’99camry U
—Headlights
1. Open the hood. Unplug the connector. Remove the rubber cover.
If the connector is tight, wiggle it.
2. Release the bulb retaining spring
and remove the bulb. Install a new
bulb and the bulb retaining spring.
To install a bulb, align the tabs of the
bulb with the cutouts of the mounting
hole.
3. Install the rubber cover with the
”TOP” mark upward, and snuggle on
the boss. Insert the connector. Then
install the plastic cover.
Make sure the rubber cover fits snugly on
the connector and the headlight body.
Aiming is not necessary after replacing
the bulb. When aiming adjustment is necessary, contact your Toyota dealer.
232
’99camry U
—Parking, front side marker
and front turn signal lights
Use a flat–bladed screwdriver. Remove
and install the cover clips as shown in
the following illustrations.
Removing cover clips
Use a flat–bladed screw driver. To protect
the surface, place several sheets of paper
over the surface.
Installing cover clips
233
’99camry U
—Rear side maker, rear turn
signal, stop and tail lights
a: Rear side marker light
b: Rear turn signal light
c: Stop and tail light
234
’99camry U
—Back–up
(type A)
and
tail
lights
—Back–up
(type B)
a: Back–up light
b: Tail light
and
tail
lights
Use a flat–bladed screwdriver. Remove
and install the cover clips as shown in
the following illustrations.
235
’99camry U
—License plate lights
Removing the cover clips
Installing the cover clips
236
Use a flat–bladed screwdriver. Remove
and install the cover clips as shown in
the following illustrations.
a: Back–up light
b: Tail light
’99camry U
—High mounted stoplight
Removing cover clips
Installing cover clips
237
’99camry U
238
’99camry U
Part 2
INFORMATION
BEFORE DRIVING
YOUR TOYOTA
Break–in period
Fuel
Drive gently and avoid high speeds.
FUEL TYPE
Your vehicle does not need an elaborate
break–in. But following a few simple tips
for the first 1600 km (1000 miles) can add
to the future economy and long life of
your vehicle:
Your new vehicle must use only unleaded gasoline.
Break–in period
Do not drive over 88 km/h (55 mph).
Run the engine at moderate speed be-
Fuel
Operation in foreign countries
Three–way catalytic converters
Engine exhaust cautions
Facts about engine oil
consumption
Twin ground electrode
platinum–tipped spark plugs
Brake system
Brake pad wear limit indicators
tween 2000 and 4000 rpm.
Avoid full–throttle starts.
Try to avoid hard stops during the first
300 km (200 miles).
Do not drive slowly with the manual
transmission in a high gear.
Do not drive for a long time at any
single speed, either fast or slow.
Do not tow a trailer during the first 800
km (500 miles).
To help prevent gas station mix–ups, your
Toyota has a new smaller fuel tank opening. The special nozzle on pumps with
unleaded fuel will fit it, but the larger
standard nozzle on pumps with leaded gas
will not.
At a minimum, the gasoline you use
should meet the specifications of ASTM
D4814 in the U.S.A. and CGSB 3.5–M93
in Canada.
NOTICE
Do not use leaded gasoline. Use of
leaded gasoline will cause the three–
way catalytic converter to lose its effectiveness and the emission control
system to function improperly. Also,
this can increase maintenance costs.
Luggage stowage precautions
Your Toyota’s identification
Theft prevention labels
Suspension and chassis
Types of tires
157
’99camry U
OCTANE RATING
5S–FE engine: Select Octane Rating 87
(Research Octane Number 91) or higher.
1MZ–FE engine: Select Octane Rating
87 (Research Octane Number 91) or
higher. For improved vehicle performance, the use of premium unleaded
gasoline with an Octane Rating 91 (Research Octane Number of 96) or higher
is recommended.
Use of unleaded gasoline with an octane
rating or research octane number lower
than stated above will cause persistent
heavy knocking. If it is severe, this will
lead to engine damage.
If your engine knocks...
If you detect heavy knocking even when
using the recommended fuel, or if you
hear steady knocking while holding a
steady speed on level roads, consult your
Toyota dealer.
However, now and then, you may notice
light knocking for a short time while accelerating or driving up hills. This is no
cause for concern.
158
GASOLINES
ADDITIVES
CONTAINING DETERGENT
Toyota recommends use of gasolines
that contain detergent additives to
avoid build–up of engine deposits.
For further details, ask your Toyota dealer
or a local gasoline retailer.
IMPROVED GASOLINES
The American Automobile Manufacturers
Association (AAMA) has developed a
specification of improved gasolines. The
AAMA specification offers optimal fuel
information for better vehicle performance and better protection of your engine.
Toyota recommends the use of gasolines
that meet the AAMA specification, if available, for improved driveability and emission control system.
GASOLINES CONTAINING MTBE
Gasolines that contain MTBE (Methyl
Tertiary–Butyl Ether) are available in the
market. If you use a gasoline mixed
with MTBE, make certain that it does
not contain more than 15% of MTBE.
GASOLINES CONTAINING MMT
Some gasolines contain an octane–enhancing additive called MMT (methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl).
Toyota does not recommend the use of
gasolines that contain MMT. If fuels containing MMT are used, your emission control system may be adversely affected.
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp on the instrument cluster may come on. If this happens, contact your Toyota dealer for service.
GASOLINES CONTAINING ALCOHOL
If you use gasohol in your Toyota, be
sure that it is unleaded, has an octane
rating no lower than 87 and does not
contain more than 10% ethanol.
Gasohol is a mixture of gasoline and ethanol.
Toyota does not recommend the use of
gasolines containing methanol. If you use
gasoline containing methanol, use only
gasoline meeting the requirements above
and also containing less than 5% methanol with cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors for methanol.
’99camry U
Operation in foreign countries
GASOLINES QUALITY
In a very few cases, you may experience
driveability problems caused by the particular gasoline that you are using. If you
continue to have unacceptable driveability,
try changing gasoline brands. If that does
not rectify your problem, then consult your
Toyota dealer.
Three–way catalytic converters
If you plan to drive your Toyota in
another country...
First, comply with the vehicle registration
laws.
Second, confirm the availability of the correct fuel (unleaded and minimum octane
number).
NOTICE
Do not use gasohol other than
stated above. It will cause fuel system damage or vehicle performance
problems.
Type A
If driveability problems are encountered (poor hot starting, vaporizing,
engine knock, etc.), discontinue the
use.
Take care not to spill gasohol during refueling. Gasohol may cause
paint damage.
FUEL TANK CAPACITY
70 L (18.5 gal., 15.4 lmp. gal.)
Type B
159
’99camry U
CAUTION
NOTICE
Keep people and combustible mate-
A large amount of unburned gases
flowing into the three–way catalytic
converter may cause it to overheat
and create a fire hazard. To prevent
this and other damage, observe the
following precautions:
rials away from the exhaust pipe
while the engine is running. The
exhaust gas is very hot.
Do not drive, idle or park your vehicle over anything that might burn
easily such as grass, leaves, paper
or rags.
Type C
The three–way catalytic converter is an
emission control device installed in the
exhaust system.
The purpose is to reduce pollutants in the
exhaust gas.
Use only unleaded gasoline.
Do not drive with an extremely low
fuel level; running out of fuel could
cause the engine to misfire, creating an excessive load on the three–
way catalytic converter.
Do not allow the engine to run at
idle speed for more than 20 minutes.
Avoid racing the engine.
Do not push–start or pull–start your
vehicle.
Do not turn off the ignition while
the vehicle is moving.
160
’99camry U
Engine exhaust cautions
Keep your engine in good running
order. Malfunctions in the engine
electrical system, electronic ignition
system/distributor ignition system
or fuel system could cause an extremely high three–way catalytic
converter temperature.
CAUTION
Avoid inhaling the engine exhaust.
It contains carbon monoxide, which
is a colorless and odorless gas. It
can cause unconsciousness or even
death.
If the engine becomes difficult to
start or stalls frequently, take your
vehicle in for a check–up as soon
as possible. Remember, your Toyota
dealer knows your vehicle and its
three–way catalytic converter system best.
Make sure the exhaust system has
To ensure that the three–way catalytic converter and the entire emission control system operate properly, your vehicle must receive the
periodic inspections required by the
Toyota Maintenance Schedule. For
scheduled maintenance information,
refer to the separate ”Scheduled
Maintenance Guide” or ”Owner’s
Manual Supplement”.
Do not run the engine in a garage
no holes or loose connections. The
system should be checked from
time to time. If you hit something,
or notice a change in the sound of
the exhaust, have the system
checked immediately.
Keep the trunk lid closed while
driving. An open or unsealed trunk
lid may cause exhaust gases to be
drawn into the vehicle.
To allow proper operation of your
vehicle’s ventilation system, keep
the inlet grilles in front of the windshield clear of snow, leaves, or other obstructions.
If you smell exhaust fumes in the
vehicle, drive with the windows
open and the trunk lid closed. Have
the cause immediately located and
corrected.
or enclosed area except for the
time needed to drive the vehicle in
or out. The exhaust gases cannot
escape, making this a particularly
dangerous situation.
Do not remain for a long time in a
parked vehicle with the engine running. If it is unavoidable, however,
do so only in an unconfined area
and adjust the heating or cooling
system to force outside air into the
vehicle.
161
’99camry U
Facts about engine oil
consumption
FUNCTIONS OF ENGINE OIL
Engine oil has the primary functions of
lubricating and cooling the inside of the
engine, and plays a major role in maintaining the engine in proper working order.
ENGINE OIL CONSUMPTION
It is normal that an engine should consume some engine oil during normal
engine operation. The causes of oil
consumption in a normal engine are as
follows.
Oil is used to lubricate pistons, piston
rings and cylinders. A thin film of oil
is left on the cylinder wall when a piston moves downwards in the cylinder.
High negative pressure generated when
the vehicle is decelerating sucks some
of this oil into the combustion chamber.
This oil as well as some part of the oil
film left on the cylinder wall is burned
by the high temperature combustion
gases during the combustion process.
Oil is also used to lubricate the stems
of the intake valves. Some of this oil
is sucked into the combustion chamber
together with the intake air and is
burned along with the fuel. High temperature exhaust gases also burn the
oil used to lubricate the exhaust valve
stems.
The amount of engine oil consumed depends on the viscosity of the oil, the
quality of the oil and the conditions the
vehicle is driven under.
More oil is consumed by high–speed driving and frequent acceleration and deceleration.
A new engine consumes more oil, since
its pistons, piston rings and cylinder walls
have not become conditioned.
When judging the amount of oil consumption, note that the oil may become
diluted and make it difficult to judge
the true level accurately.
As an example, if a vehicle is used for
repeated short trips, and consumes a normal amount of oil, the dipstick may not
show any drop in the oil level at all, even
after 1000 km (600 miles) or more. This
is because the oil is gradually becoming
diluted with fuel or moisture, making it
appear that the oil level has not changed.
162
The diluting ingredients evaporate out
when the vehicle is then driven at high
speeds, as on an express way, making it
appear that oil is excessively consumed
after driving at high speeds.
IMPORTANCE OF ENGINE OIL LEVEL
CHECK
One of the most important points in proper vehicle maintenance is to keep the engine oil at the optimum level so that oil
function will not be impaired. Therefore, it
is essential that the oil level be checked
regularly. Toyota recommends that the oil
level be checked every time you refuel
the vehicle.
NOTICE
Failure to check the oil level regularly
could lead to serious engine trouble
due to insufficient oil.
For detailed information on oil level check,
see ”Checking the engine oil level” in
Chapter 7–2.
’99camry U
Twin ground electrode
platinum–tipped spark plugs
Brake system
TANDEM
SYSTEM
MASTER
CYLINDER
BRAKE
The tandem master cylinder brake system
is a hydraulic system with two separate
sub–systems. If either sub–system should
fail, the other will still work. However, the
pedal will be harder to press, and your
stopping distance will be longer. Also, the
brake system warning light may come on.
CAUTION
Your engine is fitted with twin ground
electrode platinum–tipped spark plugs.
NOTICE
Use only twin ground electrode platinum–tipped spark plugs for your engine performance.
Do not drive your vehicle with only a
single brake system. Have your
brakes fixed immediately.
BRAKE BOOSTER
The brake booster uses engine vacuum to
power–assist the brakes. If the engine
should quit while you are driving, you can
bring the vehicle to a stop with normal
pedal pressure. There is enough reserve
vacuum for one or two stops—but no
more!
CAUTION
Do not pump the brake pedal if the
engine stalls. Each push on the
pedal uses up your vacuum reserve.
Even if the power assist is completely lost, the brakes will still
work. But you will have to push the
pedal hard—much harder than normal. And your braking distance will
be longer.
ANTI–LOCK
BRAKE
”ABS” warning light)
SYSTEM
(with
The anti–lock brake system is designed to
automatically help prevent lock–up of the
wheels during sudden braking or braking
on slippery road surfaces. This assists in
providing directional stability and steering
performance of the vehicle under these
circumstances.
The anti–lock brake system becomes operative after the vehicle has accelerated
to a speed in excess of approximately 10
km/h (6 mph). It stops operating when the
vehicle decelerate to a speed below
approximately 5 km/h (3 mph).
163
’99camry U
You may hear a sound in the engine
compartment for a few seconds when the
engine is started or just after the vehicle
is started. This means that the anti–lock
brake system is in the self check mode,
and does not indicate a malfunction.
Effective way to press the ”ABS” brake
pedal:
When the anti–lock brake system function is in action, you may feel the brake
pedal pulsating and hear a noise. In this
situation, to let the anti–lock brake system work for you, just hold the brake
pedal down more firmly. Do not pump
the brake in a panic stop. Pumping the
brake pedal makes the stopping distance
longer.
The brake pedal pulsation caused by the
anti–lock brake system may indicate hazardous road surface conditions. Although
the anti–lock brake system assists in providing vehicle control, it is still important
to drive with all due care, because the
anti–lock brake system cannot overcome
the laws of physics that act on your vehicle:
Braking capability is dependent on tire
friction with the road surface.
164
Even though the anti–lock brake system is operating, a driver cannot maintain full control on certain slippery road
surfaces, when cornering at high
speeds, or in violent maneuvers.
Avoid high speeds on wet roads. The
anti–lock brake system cannot eliminate the risk of hydroplaning and loss
of tire friction.
Always maintain a safe distance from the
vehicle in front of you. Compared with
vehicles not fitted with an anti–lock brake
system, your vehicle may require a longer
stopping distance in the following cases:
Driving on rough, gravel or snow–covered roads.
Driving with tire chains installed.
Driving on roads where the road surface is pitted or has other differences
in surface height.
”ABS” warning light
The light comes on when the ignition key
is turned to the ”ON” position. After a few
seconds, the light will go off.
If either of the following conditions occurs,
this indicates a malfunction somewhere in
the parts monitored by the warning light
system. Contact your Toyota dealer as
soon as possible to service the vehicle.
The light does not come on as described above, or remains on.
The light comes on while driving.
’99camry U
Brake pad wear limit indicators
Even if the anti–lock brake system should
fail, the brake system will still operate
conventionally. However, when the ”ABS”
warning light is on (and the brake system
warning light is off), the anti–lock brake
system is not assisting brake performance
so that the wheels can lock–up during
sudden braking or braking on slippery
road surfaces. Have your vehicle checked
by your Toyota dealer as soon as possible.
When stowing luggage or cargo in the
vehicle, observe the following:
Put luggage or cargo in the trunk when
at all possible. Be sure all items are
secured in place.
Be careful to keep the vehicle balanced. Locating the weight as far forward as possible helps maintain balance.
For better fuel economy, do not carry
unneeded weight.
DRUM–IN–DISC TYPE PARKING BRAKE
SYSTEM (1MZ–FE engine)
Your vehicle has a drum–in–disc type
parking brake system. This type of brake
system needs bedding–down of the brake
shoes periodically or whenever the parking
brake shoes and/or drums are replaced.
Have your Toyota dealer perform the bedding–down.
Luggage stowage precautions
CAUTION
The brake pad wear limit indicators on
your disc brakes give a warning noise
when the brake pads are worn to where
replacement is required.
If you hear a squealing or scraping noise
while driving, have the brake pads
checked and replaced by your Toyota
dealer as soon as possible. Expensive rotor damage can result if the pads are not
replaced when necessary.
To prevent luggage or packages
from sliding forward during
do not stack anything in
larged trunk. Keep luggage
ages low, as close to the
possible.
braking,
the enor packfloor as
165
’99camry U
Your Toyota’s identification—
—Vehicle identification
number
Never allow anyone to ride in the
enlarged trunk. It is not designed
for passengers. They should ride in
their seats with their seat belts
properly fastened. Otherwise, they
are much more likely to suffer serious bodily injury, in the event of
sudden braking or a collision.
Do not place anything on the filler
panel behind the rear seatback.
Such items may be thrown about
and possibly injure people in the
vehicle during sudden braking or an
accident.
Do not drive with objects left on
top of the instrument panel. They
may interfere with the driver’s field
of view. Or they may move during
sharp vehicle acceleration or turning, and impair the driver’s control
of the vehicle. In an accident they
may injure the vehicle occupants.
NOTICE
Do not load the vehicle beyond the
vehicle capacity weight specified in
Part 8.
166
The vehicle identification number (VIN)
is the legal identifier for your vehicle.
This number is on the left top of the
instrument panel, and can be seen
through the windshield from outside.
This is the primary identification number
for your Toyota. It is used in registering
the ownership of your vehicle.
The vehicle identification number (VIN) is
also on the Certification Label.
’99camry U
—Engine number
Theft prevention labels
The engine number is stamped on the
engine block as shown.
Your new vehicle carries theft prevention labels which are approximately 56
mm (2.20 in.) by 16 mm (0.63 in.).
The purpose of these labels is to reduce
the incidence of vehicle thefts by facilitating the tracing and recovery of parts from
stolen vehicles. The label is designed so
that once it is applied to a surface, any
attempt to remove it will result in destroying the integrity of the label. Transferring
these labels intact from one part to another, will be impossible.
5S–FE engine
NOTICE
You should not attempt to remove the
theft prevention labels as it may violate certain state or federal laws.
1MZ–FE engine
167
’99camry U
Suspension and chassis
Types of tires
CAUTION
Determine what kind of tires your vehicle is originally equipped with.
Do not modify the suspension/chassis
with lift kits, spacers, springs, etc. It
can cause dangerous vehicle handling
characteristics, resulting in loss of
control.
Summer tires are high–speed capability
tires best suited to highway driving under
dry conditions.
1. Summer tires
Since summer tires do not have the same
traction performance as snow tires, summer tires are inadequate for driving on
snow–covered or icy roads. For driving on
snow–covered or icy roads, we recommend using snow tires. If installing snow
tires, be sure to replace all four tires.
2. All season tires
All season tires are designed to provide
better traction in snow and to be adequate
for driving in most winter conditions, as
well as for use all year round.
All season tires, however, do not have
adequate traction performance compared
with snow tires in heavy or loose snow.
Also, all season tires fall short in acceleration
and
handling
performance
compared with summer tires in highway
driving.
168
CAUTION
Do not mix summer and all season
tires on your vehicle as this can
cause dangerous handling characteristics, resulting in loss of control.
Do not use tires other than the
manufacturer’s designated tires, and
never mix tires or wheels of the
sizes different from the originally
equipped tires and wheels.
’99camry U
Part 3
STARTING AND
DRIVING
Before starting the engine
How to start the engine
Tips for driving in various
conditions
Winter driving tips
Trailer towing
How to save fuel and make
your vehicle last longer, too
Before starting the engine
1. Check the area around the vehicle before entering it.
2. Adjust seat position, seatback angle,
head restraint height and steering
wheel angle.
3. Adjust inside and outside rear view
mirrors.
4. Lock all doors.
5. Fasten seat belts.
How to start the engine—
(a) Before cranking
1. Apply the parking brake firmly.
2. Turn off unnecessary lights and accessories.
3. Manual transmission: Press the clutch
pedal to the floor and shift the transmission into neutral. Hold the clutch
pedal to the floor until the engine is
started. A starter safety device will prevent the starter from operating if the
clutch pedal is not fully depressed.
Automatic transmission: Put the selector lever in ”P”. If you need to restart the engine while the vehicle is
moving, put the selector lever in ”N”.
A starter safety device will prevent the
starter from operating if the selector
lever is in any drive position.
4. Automatic transmission only: Depress the brake pedal and hold it to
the floor until driving off.
169
’99camry U
(b) Starting the engine
Before starting the engine, be sure to follow the instructions in ”(a) Before cranking”.
Normal starting procedure
The multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system in your
engine automatically controls the proper
air–fuel mixture for starting. You can start
a cold or hot engine as follows:
1. With your foot off the accelerator pedal, crank the engine by turning the key
to ”START”. Release it when the engine starts.
2. After the engine runs for about 10 seconds, you are ready to drive.
If the weather is below freezing, let the
engine warm up for a few minutes before
driving.
If the engine stalls...
Simply restart it, using the correct procedure given in normal starting.
If the engine will not start...
See ”If your vehicle will not start” in Part
4.
170
NOTICE
Do not crank for more than 30 seconds at a time. This may overheat
the starter and wiring systems.
Do not race a cold engine.
If the engine becomes difficult to
start or stalls frequently, have the
engine checked immediately.
Tips for driving in various
conditions
Always slow down in gusty crosswinds.
This will allow you much better control.
Drive slowly onto curbs and, if possible, at a right angle. Avoid driving
onto high, sharp–edged objects and
other road hazards. Failure to do so
can lead to severe tire damage resulting in tire bursts.
When parking on a hill, turn the front
wheels until they touch the curb so
that the vehicle will not roll. Apply the
parking brake, and place the transmission in ”P” (automatic) or in first or
reverse (manual). If necessary, block
the wheels.
Washing your vehicle or driving through
deep water may get the brakes wet. To
see whether they are wet, check that
there is no traffic near you, and then
press the pedal lightly. If you do not
feel a normal braking force, the brakes
are probably wet. To dry them, drive
the vehicle cautiously while lightly
pressing the brake pedal with the parking brake pulled. If they still do not
work safely, pull to the side of the road
and call a Toyota dealer for assistance.
’99camry U
Winter driving tips
CAUTION
Before driving off, make sure that
the parking brake is fully released
and the parking brake reminder
light is off.
Do not leave your vehicle unattended while the engine is running.
Do not rest your foot on the brake
pedal while driving. It can cause
dangerous overheating, needless
wear, and poor fuel economy.
To drive down a long or steep hill,
reduce your speed and downshift.
Remember, if you ride the brakes
excessively, they may overheat and
not work properly.
Be careful when accelerating, upshifting, downshifting or braking on
a slippery surface. Sudden acceleration or engine braking could cause
the vehicle to spin or skid.
Do not drive in excess of the speed
limit. Even if the legal speed limit
permits it, do not drive over 140
km/h (85 mph) unless your vehicle
has high–speed capability tires.
Driving over 140 km/h (85 mph) may
result in tire failure, loss of control
and possible injury. Be sure to consult a tire dealer to determine
whether the tires on your vehicle
are high–speed capability tires or
not before driving at such speeds.
Do not continue normal driving
when the brakes are wet. If they are
wet, your vehicle will require a
longer stopping distance, and it
may pull to one side when the
brakes are applied. Also, the parking brake will not hold the vehicle
securely.
Make sure you have a proper freeze
protection of engine coolant.
Your coolant must contain ethylene–glycol
type coolant for a proper corrosion
protection of aluminum components. Use
”Toyota Long Life Coolant” or equivalent.
See Chapter 7–2 for details about coolant
type selection.
NOTICE
Do not use alcohol type antifreeze or
plain water alone.
When it is extremely cold, we recommend
to use 60% solution for your Toyota, to
provide protection down to about –50°C
(–58°F). Do not use more than 70% solution for better coolant performance.
Check the condition of the battery and
cables.
Cold temperatures reduce the capacity of
any battery, so it must be in top shape
to provide enough power for winter starting. Chapter 7–3 tells you how to visually
inspect the battery. Your Toyota dealer
and most service stations will be pleased
to check the level of charge.
171
’99camry U
Trailer towing
Make sure the engine oil viscosity is
suitable for the cold weather.
Do not use your parking brake when
there is a possibility it could freeze.
See Chapter 7–2 for recommended viscosity. Leaving a heavy summer oil in your
vehicle during winter months may cause
harder starting. If you are not sure about
which oil to use, call your Toyota dealer—he will be pleased to help.
Keep the door locks from freezing.
When parking, put the transmission into
”P” (automatic) or into first or reverse
(manual) and block the rear wheels. Do
not use the parking brake, or snow or
water accumulated in and around the
parking brake mechanism may freeze,
making it hard to release.
Squirt lock de–icer or glycerine into the
locks to keep them from freezing.
Keep ice and snow from accumulating
under the fenders.
Use a washer fluid containing an antifreeze solution.
Ice and snow built up under your fenders
can make steering difficult. During bad
winter driving, stop and check under the
fenders occasionally.
This product is available at your Toyota
dealer and most auto parts stores. Follow
the manufacturer’s directions for how
much to mix with water.
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or any
other substitute because it may damage your vehicle’s paint.
172
Depending on where you are driving,
we recommend you carry some emergency equipment.
Some of the things you might put in the
vehicle are tire chains, window scraper,
bag of sand or salt, flares, small shovel,
jumper cables, etc.
Your vehicle is designed primarily as a
passenger–carrying vehicle. Towing a
trailer will have an adverse effect on
handling, performance, braking, durability
and driving economy (fuel consumption,
etc.). Your safety and satisfaction depend
on the proper use of correct equipment
and cautious driving habits. For your
safety and the safety of others, you must
not overload your vehicle or trailer. Toyota
warranties do not apply to damage or
malfunction caused by towing a trailer for
commercial purposes. Ask your local
Toyota dealer for further details before
towing.
NOTICE
When towing a trailer, be sure to consult your Toyota dealer for further information on additional requirements
such as a towing kit, etc.
’99camry U
WEIGHT LIMITS
Trailer hitch assemblies have differ-
Before towing, make sure the total trailer
weight, gross vehicle weight, gross axle
weight and trailer tongue load are all within the limits.
ent weight capacities established by
the hitch manufacturer. Even though
the vehicle may be physically capable of towing a higher weight, the
operator must determine the maximum weight rating of the particular
hitch assembly and never exceed
the maximum weight rating specified for the trailer–hitch. Exceeding
the maximum weight rating set by
the trailer hitch manufacturer can
cause an accident resulting in serious personal injuries.
The total trailer weight and tongue load
can be measured with platform scales
found at a highway weighing station, building supply company, trucking company,
junk yard, etc.
CAUTION
The
total trailer weight (trailer
weight plus its cargo load) must
not exceed 907 kg (2000 lb.). Exceeding this weight is dangerous.
The gross vehicle weight must not
exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight
Rating (GVWR) indicated on the
Certification Label. The gross vehicle weight is the sum of weights
of the unloaded vehicle, driver, passengers, luggage, hitch and trailer
tongue load. It also includes the
weight of any special equipment
installed on your vehicle.
173
’99camry U
The load on either the front or rear
axle resulting from distribution of
the gross vehicle weight on both
axles must not exceed the Gross
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) listed
on the Certification Label.
HITCHES
Total trailer weight
Tongue load
Use only a hitch which is recommended by the hitch manufacturer and
conforms to the total trailer weight requirement.
Follow the directions supplied by the
hitch manufacturer. Lubricate the hitch
ball with a light coat of grease.
Toyota recommends removing the trailTongue load
Total trailer weight
100 = 9 to 11%
er hitch whenever you are not towing
a trailer to reduce the possibility of
additional damage caused by the hitch
if your vehicle is struck from behind.
The trailer cargo load should be
distributed so that the tongue load
is 9 to 11% of the total trailer
weight, not exceeding the maximum
of 90 kg (200 lb.). Never load the
trailer with more weight in the back
than in the front. About 60% of the
trailer load should be in the front
half of the trailer and the remaining
40% in the rear.
NOTICE
Do not use axle–mounted hitches as
they can cause damage to the axle
housing, wheel bearings, wheels or
tires. Also, never install a hitch which
may interfere with the normal function
of an Energy Absorbing Bumper, if so
equipped.
BRAKES AND SAFETY CHAINS
Toyota
recommends trailers with
brakes that conform to any applicable federal and state/provincial regulations.
174
’99camry U
A safety chain must always be used
between the towing vehicle and the
trailer. Leave sufficient slack in the
chain for turns. The chain should
cross under the trailer tongue to
prevent the tongue from dropping to
the ground in case it becomes damaged or separated. For correct safety
chain procedures, follow the hitch or
trailer manufacturer’s recommendations.
CAUTION
If the total trailer weight exceeds
453 kg (1000 lb.), trailer brakes are
required.
Never tap into your vehicle’s hydraulic system as it would lower its
braking effectiveness.
Never tow a trailer without using a
safety chain securely attached to
both the trailer and the vehicle. If
damage occurs to the coupling unit
or hitch ball, there is danger of the
trailer wandering over into another
lane.
TIRES
TRAILER LIGHTS
Ensure that your vehicle’s tires are
Trailer lights must comply with federal,
properly inflated. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended cold tire
pressure indicated below (see Chapter
7–2 for instructions.):
state/provincial and local regulations.
See your local recreational vehicle
dealer or rental agency for the correct
type of wiring and relays for your trailer. Check for correct operation of the
turn signals and stop lights each time
you hitch up. Direct splicing may damage your vehicle’s electrical system
and cause a malfunction of your lights.
Tire pressure, kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi)
5S–FE engine
Front
210 (2.1, 30)
Rear
210 (2.1, 30)
1MZ–FE engine
Front
220 (2.2, 32)
Rear
220 (2.2, 32)
The trailer tires should be inflated to
the pressure recommended by the trailer manufacturer in respect to the total
trailer weight.
BREAK–IN SCHEDULE
Toyota recommends that you do not
tow a trailer with a new vehicle or a
vehicle with any new power train component (engine, transmission, differential, wheel bearing, etc.) for the first
800 km (500 miles) of driving.
MAINTENANCE
If you tow a trailer, your vehicle will
require more frequent maintenance due
to the additional load. For this information, please refer to the scheduled
maintenance information in the ”Scheduled Maintenance Guide” or ”Owner’s
Manual Supplement”.
Retighten all fixing bolts of the towing
ball and bracket after approximately
1000 km (600 miles) of trailer driving.
175
’99camry U
PRE–TOWING SAFETY CHECK
Check that your vehicle remains level
when a loaded or unloaded trailer is
hitched. Do not drive if the vehicle has
an abnormal nose–up or nose–down
condition, and check for improper
tongue load, overload,worn suspension
or other possible causes.
Make sure the trailer cargo is securely
loaded so that it can not shift.
Check that your rear view mirrors conform to any applicable federal, state/
provincial or local regulation. If not,
install the rear view mirrors required
for towing purpose.
TRAILER TOWING TIPS
When towing a trailer, your vehicle will
handle differently than when not towing. The three main causes of vehicle–
trailer accidents are driver error, excessive speed and improper trailer loading.
Keep these in mind when towing:
Before starting out, check operation of
the lights and all vehicle–trailer connections. After driving a short distance,
stop and recheck the lights and connections. Before actually towing a trailer, practice turning, stopping and backing with a trailer in an area away from
traffic until you learn the feel.
176
Backing with a trailer is difficult and
Avoid jerky steering and sharp turns.
requires practice. Grip the bottom of
the steering wheel and move your hand
to the left to move the trailer to the
left. Move your hand to the right to
move the trailer to the right. (This procedure is generally opposite to that
when backing without a trailer). Also,
just turn the steering wheel a little at
a time, avoiding sharp or prolonged
turning. Have someone guide you when
backing to reduce the risk of an accident.
The trailer could hit your vehicle in a
tight turn. Slow down before making a
turn to avoid the necessity of sudden
braking.
Because stopping distance may be increased, vehicle–to–vehicle distance
should be increased when towing a
trailer. For each 16 km/h (10 mph) of
speed, allow at least one vehicle and
trailer length between you and the vehicle ahead. Avoid sudden braking as
you may skid, resulting in jackknifing
and loss of control. This is especially
true on wet or slippery surfaces.
Avoid jerky starts or sudden acceleration. If your vehicle has a manual
transmission, prevent excessive clutch
slippage by keeping engine rpm low
and not racing the engine. Always start
out in first gear.
Remember that when making a turn,
the trailer wheels will be closer than
the vehicle wheels to the inside of the
turn. Therefore, compensate for this by
making a larger than normal turning
radius with your vehicle.
Crosswinds and rough roads will adversely affect handling of your vehicle
and trailer, causing sway. Pay attention
to the rear from time to time to prepare yourself for being passed by large
trucks or buses, which may cause your
vehicle and trailer to sway. If swaying
happens, firmly grip the steering wheel
and reduce speed immediately but
gradually. Never increase speed. Steer
straight ahead. If you make no extreme
correction with the steering or brakes,
the vehicle and trailer will stabilize.
Be careful when passing other vehicles. Passing requires considerable
distance. After passing a vehicle, do
not forget the length of your trailer and
be sure you have plenty of room before changing lanes.
’99camry U
In order to maintain engine braking efficiency do not use fifth gear (manual
transmission) or overdrive (automatic
transmission).
Because of the added load of the trailer, your vehicle’s engine may overheat
on hot days (at temperatures over
30C [85F]) when going up a long or
steep grade with a trailer. If the engine
coolant temperature gauge indicates
overheating, immediately turn off the air
conditioning (if in use), pull off the road
and stop in a safe spot. Refer to ”If
your vehicle overheats” in Part 4 of
this manual.
Always place wheel blocks under both
the vehicle and trailer wheels when
parking. Apply the parking brake firmly.
Put the transmission in ”P” (automatic)
or in first or reverse (manual). Avoid
parking on a slope with a trailer, but
if it cannot be avoided, do so only
after performing the following:
1. Apply the brakes and hold.
2. Have someone place wheel blocks under both the vehicle and trailer wheels.
3. When the wheel blocks are in place,
release your brakes slowly until the
blocks absorb the load.
4. Apply the parking brake firmly.
5. Shift into first or reverse (manual) or
”P” (automatic) and turn off the engine.
CAUTION
Do not exceed 72 km/h (45 mph) or
the posted towing speed limit,whichever is lower. Because instability (swaying) of a towing vehicle–
trailer
combination
usually
increases as the speed increases,exceeding 72 km/h (45 mph) may
cause loss of control.
When restarting out after parking on a
slope:
Slow down and downshift before
1. With the transmission in ”P” position
(automatic) or the clutch pedal depressed (manual), start the engine.
(With an automatic transmission, be
sure to keep the brake pedal depressed.)
Avoid holding the brake pedal down
2. Shift into gear.
descending steep or long downhill
grades. Do not make sudden downshifts.
too long or too frequently. This
could cause the brakes to overheat
and result in reduced braking efficiency.
3. Release the parking brake (also foot
brake on automatic transmission vehicles) and slowly pull or back away
from the wheel blocks. Stop and apply
your brakes.
4. Have someone retrieve the blocks.
177
’99camry U
How to save fuel and make
your vehicle last longer, too
Getting more kilometers/mileage from a
liter/gallon of fuel is easy—just take it
easy. It will help make your vehicle last
longer, too. Here are some specific tips
on how to save money on both fuel and
repairs:
Avoid engine lug or overrevving. Use
Keep the front wheels in proper
a gear position suitable for the road on
which you are travelling.
alignment. Avoid hitting the curb and
slow down on rough roads. Improper
alignment not only causes faster tire
wear but also puts an extra load on
the engine, which, in turn, wastes fuel.
Keep your tires inflated at the cor-
Avoid
rect pressure. Underinflation causes
tire wear and wastes fuel. See Chapter
7–2 for instructions.
Do not carry unneeded weight in
your vehicle. Excess weight puts a
heavier load on the engine, causing
greater fuel consumption.
Avoid lengthy warm–up idling. Once
the engine is running smoothly, begin
driving—but gently. Remember, however, that on cold winter days this may
take a little longer.
Accelerate
slowly and smoothly.
Avoid jackrabbit starts. Get into high
gear as quickly as possible.
Avoid long engine idling. If you have
a long wait and you are not in traffic,
it is better to turn off the engine and
start again later.
178
Avoid continuous speeding up and
slowing down.
wastes fuel.
Stop–and–go
driving
unnecessary stopping and
braking. Maintain a steady pace. Try
to time the traffic signals so you only
need to stop as little as possible or
take advantage of through streets to
avoid traffic lights. Keep a proper distance from other vehicles to avoid sudden braking. This will also reduce wear
on your brakes.
Avoid heavy traffic or traffic jams
whenever possible.
Do not rest your foot on the clutch
or brake pedal. This causes needless
wear, overheating and poor fuel economy.
Maintain a moderate speed on highways. The faster you drive,the greater
the fuel consumption. By reducing your
speed, you will cut down on fuel consumption.
Keep the bottom of your vehicle free
from mud, etc. This not only lessens
weight but also helps prevent corrosion.
Keep your vehicle tuned–up and in
top shape. A dirty air cleaner, improper valve clearance, dirty plugs, dirty oil
and grease,brakes not adjusted, etc. all
lower engine performance and contribute to poor fuel economy. For longer
life of all parts and lower operating
costs, keep all maintenance work on
schedule, and if you often drive under
severe conditions, see that your vehicle
receives more frequent maintenance
(For scheduled maintenance information, please refer to the separate
”Scheduled Maintenance Guide” or
”Owner’s Manual Supplement”).
’99camry U
CAUTION
Never turn off the engine to coast
down hills. Your power steering and
brake booster will not function without the engine running. Also, the
emission control system operates
properly only when the engine is running.
179
’99camry U
180
’99camry U
Part 4
IN CASE OF AN
EMERGENCY
If your vehicle will not start
If your engine stalls while
driving
If your vehicle overheats
If you have a flat tire
If your vehicle needs to be
towed
If you cannot shift automatic
transmission selector lever
If you lose your keys
If you lose your wireless remote
control transmitter
If your vehicle will not start—
(a) Simple checks
Before making these checks, make sure
you have followed the correct starting procedure given in ”How to start the engine”
in Part 3 and that you have sufficient fuel.
If your vehicle is equipped with the engine
immobiliser system, also check whether
the other keys will start the engine. If
they work, your key may be broken. Have
the key checked at your Toyota dealer. If
none of your keys work, the system is
possibly broken. Call your Toyota dealer.
(See ”Keys (with engine immobiliser system)” in Chapter 1–2.)
If the engine is not turning over or is
turning over too slowly—
1. Check that the battery terminals are
tight and clean.
2. If the battery terminals are O.K., switch
on the interior light.
NOTICE
Do not pull– or push–start the vehicle. It may damage the vehicle or
cause a collision when the engine
starts. Also the three–way catalytic
converter may overheat and become a
fire hazard.
If the engine turns over at its normal
speed but will not start—
1. Check that all the push–on connectors
are tight. (For example, connectors at
the spark plugs, ignition coil and/or distributor)
2. If the connectors are O.K., the engine
may be flooded because of repeated
cranking. See ”(b) Starting a flooded
engine” for further instructions.
3. If the light is out, dim or goes out
when the starter is cranked, the battery
is discharged. You may try jump starting. See ”(c) Jump starting” for further
instructions.
If the light is O.K., but the engine still will
not start, it needs adjustment or repair.
Call a Toyota dealer or qualified repair
shop.
181
’99camry U
(b) Starting a flooded engine
(c) Jump starting
If the engine will not start, your engine
may be flooded because of repeated
cranking.
To avoid serious personal injury and
damage to your vehicle which might result from battery explosion, acid burns,
electrical burns, or damaged electronic
components, these instructions must be
followed precisely.
If this happens, turn the key to ”START”
with the accelerator pedal held down.
Keep the key and accelerator pedal so for
15 seconds and release them. Then try
starting the engine with your foot off the
accelerator pedal.
If the engine does not start after 30 seconds of cranking, release the key, wait
a few minutes and try again.
If the engine still will not start, it needs
adjustment or repair. Call a Toyota dealer
or qualified repair shop for assistance.
NOTICE
Do not crank for more than 30 seconds at a time. This may overheat
the starter and wiring systems.
182
If you are unsure about how to follow this
procedure, we strongly recommend that
you seek the help of a competent mechanic or towing service.
CAUTION
Batteries
contain
sulfuric
acid
which is poisonous and corrosive.
Wear protective safety glasses when
jump starting, and avoid spilling
acid on your skin, clothing, or vehicle.
If you should accidentally get acid
on yourself or in your eyes, remove
any contaminated clothing and flush
the affected area with water immediately. Then get immediate medical
attention. If possible, continue to
apply water with a sponge or cloth
while enroute to the medical office.
The gas normally produced by a
battery will explode if a flame or
spark is brought near. Use only
standardised jumper cables and do
not smoke or light a match while
jump starting.
NOTICE
The battery used for boosting must
be 12 V. Do not jump start unless you
are sure that the booster battery is
correct.
’99camry U
JUMP STARTING PROCEDURE
Discharged
battery
1. If the booster battery is installed in
another vehicle, make sure the vehicles
are not touching. Turn off all unnecessary lights and accessories.
2. If required, remove all the vent plugs
from the booster and discharged batteries. Lay a cloth over the open vents
on the batteries. (This helps reduce the
explosion hazard, personal injuries and
burns.)
3. If the engine in the vehicle with the
booster battery is not running, start it
and let it run for a few minutes. During
jump starting run the engine at about
2000 rpm with the accelerator pedal
lightly depressed.
Jumper cable
Booster
battery
Positive
Jumper
terminal
(”+” mark) cable
Positive terminal
(”+” mark)
4. Make the cable connections in the order a, b, c, d.
a. Connect the clamp of the positive
(red) jumper cable to the positive ( )
terminal on the discharged battery.
b. Connect the clamp at the other end
of the positive (red) jumper cable to
the positive ( ) terminal on the booster
battery.
Discharged
battery
Negative
terminal (”–” mark)
Booster
battery
c. Connect the clamp of the negative
(black) jumper cable to the negative
( ) terminal on the booster battery.
d. Connect the clamp at the other end
of the negative (black) jumper cable to
a solid, stationary, unpainted, metallic
point of the vehicle with the discharged
battery.
The recommended connecting points
are shown in the following illustrations:
183
’99camry U
If your engine stalls while
driving
Do not connect it to or near any part
that moves when the engine is
cranked.
CAUTION
When making the connections, to
avoid serious injury, do not lean over
the battery or accidentally let the
jumper cables or clamps touch anything except the correct battery terminals or the ground.
Connecting point for 5S–FE engine
5. Start your engine in the normal way.
After starting, run it at about 2000 rpm
for several minutes with the accelerator
pedal lightly depressed.
6. Carefully disconnect the cables in the
exact reverse order: the negative cable
and then the positive cable.
7. Carefully dispose of the battery cover
cloths—they may now contain sulfuric
acid.
8. If removed, replace all the battery vent
plugs.
Connecting point for 1MZ–FE engine
184
If the cause of your battery discharging is
not apparent (for example, lights left on),
you should have it checked.
If your engine stalls while driving...
1. Reduce your speed gradually, keeping
a straight line. Move cautiously off the
road to a safe place.
2. Turn on your emergency flashers.
3. Try starting the engine again.
If the engine will not start, see ”If your
vehicle will not start”.
CAUTION
If the engine is not running, the power assist for the brakes and steering
will not work so steering and braking
will be much harder than usual.
’99camry U
If your vehicle overheats
If your engine coolant temperature
gauge indicates overheating, if you experience a loss of power, or if you hear
a loud knocking or pinging noise, the
engine has probably overheated. You
should follow this procedure...
3. Look for obvious coolant leaks from the
radiator, hoses,and under the vehicle.
However, note that water draining from
the air conditioning is normal if it has
been used.
1. Pull safely off the road, stop the vehicle and turn on your emergency
flashers. Put the transmission in ”P”
(automatic) or neutral (manual) and apply the parking brake. Turn off the air
conditioning if it is being used.
CAUTION
2. If coolant or steam is boiling out of the
radiator or reservoir,stop the engine.
Wait until the steam subsides before
opening the hood. If there is no coolant
boiling over or steam, leave the engine
running and make sure the electric
cooling fan is operating. If it is not,
turn the ignition off.
6. After the engine coolant temperature
has cooled to normal, again check the
coolant level in the reservoir. If necessary, bring it up to half full again. Serious coolant loss indicates a leak in the
system. You should have it checked as
soon as possible at your Toyota dealer.
When the engine is running, keep
hands and clothing away from the
moving fan and engine drive belts.
4. If the coolant is leaking, stop the engine immediately. Call a Toyota dealer
for assistance.
5. If there are no obvious leaks, check
the coolant reservoir. If it is dry, add
coolant to the reservoir while the engine is running. Fill it about half full.
CAUTION
CAUTION
To help avoid personal injury, keep
the hood closed until there is no
steam. Escaping steam or coolant is
a sign of very high pressure.
Do not attempt to remove the radiator
cap when the engine and radiator are
hot. Serious injury could result from
scalding hot fluid and steam blown
out under pressure.
185
’99camry U
If you have a flat tire—
1. Reduce your speed gradually, keeping
a straight line. Move cautiously off the
road to a safe place well away from
the traffic. Avoid stopping on the center
divider of a highway. Park on a level
spot with firm ground.
2. Stop the engine and
emergency flashers.
turn on
your
3. Firmly set the parking brake and put
the transmission in ”P” (automatic) or
reverse (manual).
4. Have everyone get out of the vehicle
on the side away from traffic.
Stop the vehicle on a level firm
ground, firmly set the parking brake
and put the transmission in ”P”
(automatic) or reverse (manual).
Block the wheel diagonally opposite
to the one being changed if necessary.
Make sure to set the jack properly
in the jack point. Raising the vehicle with jack improperly positioned will damage the vehicle or
may allow the vehicle to fall off the
jack and cause personal injury.
5. Read the following instructions thoroughly.
Never get under the vehicle when
CAUTION
Use the jack only for lifting your
When jacking, be sure to observe the
following to reduce the possibility of
personal injury:
Follow jacking instructions.
Do not start or run the engine while
your vehicle is supported by the
jack.
186
the vehicle is supported by the jack
alone.
vehicle during wheel changing.
Do not raise the vehicle with someone in the vehicle.
When raising the vehicle, do not
put an object on or under the jack.
Raise the vehicle only high enough
to remove and change the tire.
NOTICE
Do not continue driving with a deflated tire. Driving even a short distance can damage a tire beyond repair.
’99camry U
—Required tools and spare
tire
1. Get the required tools and spare
tire.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Wheel nut wrench
Jack
Jack handle
Spare tire
To prepare yourself for an emergency, you
should familiarize yourself with the use of
the jack, each of the tools and their storage locations.
Turn the jack joint by hand.
To remove the spare tire:
To remove: Turn the joint in direction 1
until the jack is free.
To store: Turn the joint in direction 2 until
the jack is firmly secured to prevent it
flying forward during a collision or sudden
braking.
1. Loosen the nut and remove it.
2. Remove the spare tire cover.
3. Loosen the bolt and remove it.
4. Remove the spacer.
Then take the spare tire out of the vehicle.
When storing the spare tire, put it in place
with the outer side of the wheel facing up.
Then secure the tire by repeating the
above removal steps in reverse order to
prevent it from flying forward during a
collision or sudden braking.
187
’99camry U
—Blocking the wheel
—Removing wheel ornament
3. Remove the wheel ornament.
Pry off the wheel ornament, using the
beveled end of the wheel nut wrench as
shown.
CAUTION
Do not try to pull off the ornament by
hand. Take due care in handling the
ornament to avoid unexpected personal injury.
2. Block the wheel diagonally opposite
the flat tire to keep the vehicle from
rolling when it is jacked up.
Steel wheels
When blocking the wheel, place a wheel
block from the front for the front wheels
or from the rear for the rear wheels.
Aluminium wheels
188
’99camry U
—Loosening wheel nuts
—Positioning the jack
—Raising your vehicle
4. Loosen all the wheel nuts.
5. Position the jack at the correct jack
point as shown.
6. After making sure that no one is in
the vehicle, raise it high enough so
that the spare tire can be installed.
Always loosen the wheel nuts before raising the vehicle.
The nuts turn counterclockwise to loosen.
To get maximum leverage, fit the wrench
to the nut so that the handle is on the
right side, as shown above. Grab the
wrench near the end of the handle and
pull up on the handle. Be careful that the
wrench does not slip off the nut.
Do not remove the nuts yet—just unscrew
them about one–half turn.
Make sure the jack is positioned on a
level and solid place.
Remember you will need more ground
clearance when putting on the spare tire
than when removing the flat tire.
To raise the vehicle, insert the jack handle
into the jack (it is a loose fit) and turn it
clockwise. As the jack touches the vehicle
and begins to lift, double–check that it is
properly positioned.
189
’99camry U
—Changing wheels
CAUTION
Never get under the vehicle when the
vehicle is supported by the jack
alone.
7. Remove the wheel nuts and change
tires.
Lift the flat tire straight off and put it
aside.
Roll the spare wheel into position and
align the holes in the wheel with the bolts.
Then lift up the wheel and get at least the
top bolt started through its hole. Wiggle
the tire and press it back over the other
bolts.
190
Before putting on wheels, remove any corrosion on the mounting surfaces with a
wire brush or such. Installation of wheels
without good metal–to–metal contact at the
mounting surface can cause wheel nuts to
loosen and eventually cause a wheel to
come off while driving. Therefore after the
first 1600 km (1000 miles), check to see
that the wheel nuts are tight.
’99camry U
—Reinstalling wheel nuts
—Lowering your vehicle
CAUTION
When lowering the vehicle, make sure
all portions of your body and all other persons around will not be injured
as the vehicle is lowered to the
ground.
8. Reinstall all the wheel nuts finger
tight.
9. Lower the vehicle completely and
tighten the wheel nuts.
Reinstall the wheel nuts (tapered end inward) and tighten them as much as you
can by hand. Press back on the tire and
see if you can tighten them more.
Turn the jack handle counterclockwise to
lower the vehicle.
Use only the wheel nut wrench to tighten
the nuts. Do not use other tools or any
additional leverage other than your hands,
such as a hammer, pipe or your foot.
Make sure the wrench is securely engaged over the nut.
Tighten each nut a little at a time in the
order shown. Repeat the process until all
the nuts are tight.
191
’99camry U
—Reinstalling wheel ornament
—After changing wheels
10. Reinstall the wheel ornament.
1. Put the wheel ornament into position.
On some models, align the cutout of the
wheel ornament with the valve stem as
shown.
2. Then tap it firmly with the side or heel
of your hand to snap it into place.
CAUTION
Steel wheels
Take due care in handling the ornament to avoid unexpected personal
injury.
11. Check the air pressure of the replaced tire.
Adjust the air pressure to the specification
designed in Part 8. If the pressure is lower, drive slowly to the nearest service station and fill to the correct pressure.
Do not forget to reinstall the tire inflation
valve cap as dirt and moisture could get
into the valve core and possibly cause air
leakage. If the cap is missing, have a new
one put on as soon as possible.
12. Restow all the tools, jack and flat
tire securely.
As soon after changing wheels as possible, tighten the wheel nuts to the torque
specified in Part 8 with a torque wrench
and have a technician repair the flat tire.
CAUTION
Before driving, make sure all the
tools, jack and flat tire are securely
in place in their storage location to
reduce the possibility of personal injury during a collision or sudden
braking.
Aluminum wheels
192
’99camry U
If your vehicle needs to be
towed—
(a) Towing with wheel lift type truck—
—From front
—From rear
If towing is necessary, we recommend
you to have it done by your Toyota
dealer or a commercial tow truck service. In consultation with them, have
your vehicle towed using either (a) or
(b).
Only when you cannot receive a towing
service from a Toyota dealer or commercial tow truck service, tow your vehicle carefully in accordance with the
instructions given in ”—Emergency towing” in this part.
Proper equipment will help ensure that
your vehicle is not damaged while being
towed. Commercial operators are generally
aware of the state/provincial and local
laws pertaining to towing.
(b) Using flat bed truck
Your vehicle can be damaged if it is
towed incorrectly. Although most operators
know the correct procedure, it is possible
to make a mistake. To avoid damage to
your vehicle, make sure the following few
precautions are observed. If necessary,
show this page to the tow truck driver.
TOWING PRECAUTIONS:
Use a safety chain system for all towing,
and abide by the state/provincial and local
laws. The wheels and axle on the ground
must be in good condition. If they are
damaged, use a towing dolly.
(a) Towing with wheel lift type truck
From front—Release the parking brake.
NOTICE
When lifting wheels, take care to ensure adequate ground clearance for
towing at the opposite end of the
raised vehicle. Otherwise, the bumper
and/or underbody of the towed vehicle
will be damaged during towing.
From rear—
Manual transmission:
We recommend using a towing dolly
under the front wheels. If you do not
use a towing dolly, place the ignition
key in the ”ACC” position and put the
transmission in neutral.
NOTICE
Do not tow with the key removed or
in the ”LOCK” position when towing
from the rear without a towing dolly.
The steering lock mechanism is not
strong enough to hold the front
wheels straight.
193
’99camry U
—Emergency towing
Automatic transmission:
Use a towing dolly under the front
wheels.
(c) Towing with sling type
truck
NOTICE
Never tow a vehicle with an automatic
transmission from the rear with the
front wheels on the ground, as this
may cause serious damage to the
transmission.
(b) Using flat bed truck
(c) Towing with sling type truck
NOTICE
Do not tow with sling type truck, either from the front or rear. This may
cause body damage.
If towing is necessary, we recommend
you to have it done by your Toyota
dealer or a commercial tow truck service.
If towing service is not available in an
emergency, your vehicle may be temporarily towed by a cable or chain secured to one of the emergency towing
eyelets under the vehicle. Use extreme
caution when towing vehicles.
A driver must be in the vehicle to steer
it and operate the brakes.
Towing in this manner may be done only
on hard–surfaced roads for a short distance and at low speeds. Also, the
wheels, axles, drive train,steering and
brakes must all be in good condition.
194
’99camry U
If you cannot shift automatic
transmission selector lever
CAUTION
CAUTION
Use extreme caution when towing vehicles. Avoid sudden starts or erratic
driving maneuvers which would place
excessive stress on the emergency
towing eyelets and towing cable or
chain. The eyelets and towing cable
or chain may break and cause serious
injury or damage.
If the engine is not running, the power assist for the brakes and steering
will not work so steering and braking
will be much harder than usual.
NOTICE
Use only a cable or chain specifically
intended for use in towing vehicles.
Securely fasten the cable or chain to
the towing eyelets provided.
Before towing, release the parking brake
and put the transmission in neutral (manual) or ”N” (automatic). The key must be
in ”ACC” (engine off) or ”ON” (engine running).
If you cannot shift the selector lever
out of ”P” position to other positions
even though the brake pedal is depressed, use the shift lock override button as follows:
1. Turn the ignition key to
position. Make sure the
brake is on.
”LOCK”
parking
2. Pry up the cover with a flat–bladed
screwdriver or equivalent.
195
’99camry U
If you lose your keys
Please contact your nearest Toyota
dealer and ask for duplicating key. You
must inform of the key number and, in
case of making the immobiliser key,
one of the master keys must be presented.
See the suggestion given in ”Keys” in
Chapter 1–2.
3. Insert your finger into the
push down the shift lock
button. You can shift out
position only while pushing
ton.
hole to
override
of ”P”
the but-
4. Shift into ”N” position.
5. Insert the cover.
6. Start the engine. For your safety,
keep the brake pedal depressed.
Be sure to have the system checked by
your Toyota dealer as soon as possible.
196
If your keys are locked in the vehicle and
you cannot get a duplicate, many Toyota
dealers can still open the door for you,
using their special tools. If you must
break a window to get in, we suggest
breaking the smallest side window because it is the least expensive to replace.
Be extremely cautious to avoid cuts from
the glass.
Vehicles with engine immobiliser system—
Even if you lose only one key, contact
your Toyota dealer to make a new key.
However, if you loose all your master
keys, the dealer cannot duplicate key but
only replace the whole system.
If you lose your wireless
remote control transmitter
If you lose your transmitter, you can
purchase a new one at your Toyota
dealer.
You can use the wireless remote control
system with the new transmitter. Contact
your Toyota dealer for detailed information.
’99camry U
Part 5
CORROSION
PREVENTION AND
APPEARANCE CARE
Protecting your Toyota from
corrosion
Washing and waxing your Toyota
Cleaning the interior
Protecting your Toyota
from corrosion
Toyota, through its diligent research, design and use of the most advanced
technology available, has done its part to
help prevent corrosion and has provided
you with the finest quality vehicle
construction. Now, it is up to you. Proper
care of your Toyota can help ensure long–
term corrosion prevention.
The most common causes of corrosion
to your vehicle are:
The accumulation of road salt, dirt and
moisture in hard–to–reach areas under
the vehicle.
Chipping
of paint, or undercoating
caused by minor accidents or by
stones and gravel.
Care is especially important if you live
in particular areas or operate your vehicle under certain environmental conditions:
Road salt or dust control chemicals will
accelerate corrosion, as will the presence of salt in the air near the sea–
coast or in areas of industrial pollution.
High humidity accelerates corrosion especially when temperatures range just
above the freezing point.
Wetness or dampness to certain parts
of your vehicle for an extended period
of time, may cause corrosion even
though other parts of the vehicle may
be dry.
High temperatures will cause corrosion
to those components of the vehicle
which are prevented from quick–drying
due to lack of proper ventilation.
The above signifies the necessity to keep
your vehicle, particularly the underside, as
clean as possible and to repair any damage to paint or protective coatings as
soon as possible.
To help prevent corrosion on
Toyota, follow these guidelines:
your
Wash your vehicle frequently. It is, of
course, necessary to keep your vehicle
clean by regular washing, but to prevent
corrosion, the following points should be
observed:
If you drive on salted roads in the
winter or if you live near the ocean,
you should hose off the undercarriage
at least once a month to minimize corrosion.
197
’99camry U
Washing and waxing your
Toyota
High pressure water or steam is effective for cleaning the vehicle’s underside
and wheel housings. Pay particular
attention to these areas as it is difficult
to see all the mud and dirt. It will do
more harm than good to simply wet the
mud and debris without removing them.
The lower edge of doors, rocker panels
and frame members have drain holes
which should not be allowed to clog
with dirt as trapped water in these
areas can cause corrosion.
Wash the underside of the vehicle thoroughly when winter is over.
See ”Washing and waxing your Toyota” for
more tips.
Check the condition of your vehicle’s
paint and trim. If you find any chips or
scratches in the paint, touch them up immediately to prevent corrosion from starting. If the chips or scratches have gone
through the bare metal, have a qualified
body shop make the repair.
198
Check the interior of your vehicle. Water and dirt can accumulate under the
floor mats and could cause corrosion. Occasionally check under the mats to make
sure the area is dry. Be particularly careful when transporting chemicals, cleansers, fertilizers, salt, etc.; these should be
transported in proper containers. If a spill
or leak should occur, immediately clean
and dry the area.
Use mud shields on your wheels. If you
drive on salted or gravel roads, mud
shields help protect your vehicle. Full–size
shields, which come as near to the ground
as possible, are the best. We recommend
that the fittings and the area where the
shields are installed be treated to resist
corrosion. Your Toyota dealer will be
happy to assist in supplying and installing
the shields if they are recommended for
your area.
Keep your vehicle in a well ventilated
garage or a roofed place. Do not park
your vehicle in a damp, poorly ventilated garage. If you wash your vehicle in
the garage, or if you drive it in covered
with water or snow, your garage may be
so damp it will cause corrosion. Even if
your garage is heated, a wet vehicle can
corrode if the ventilation is poor.
Washing your Toyota
Keep your
washing.
vehicle
clean
by
regular
The following cases may cause weakness
to the paint or corrosion to the body and
parts. Wash your vehicle as soon as possible.
When driving in a coastal area
When driving on a road sprinkled with
antifreeze
When having stuck of coal tar, tree
sap, bird droppings and carcass of an
insect
When driving in the areas where there
is a lot of smoke, soot, dust, iron dust
and chemical substance
When the vehicle becomes remarkably
dirty with dust and mud
Hand–washing your Toyota
Work in the shade and wait until the
vehicle body is not hot to the touch.
CAUTION
When cleaning under floor or chassis,
be careful not to injure your hands.
’99camry U
1. Rinse off loose dirt with a hose. Remove any mud or road salt from the
underside of the vehicle or in the
wheel wells.
4. To prevent water spots, dry the vehicle
using a clean soft cotton towel. Do not
rub or press hard—you might scratch
the paint.
2. Wash with a mild car–wash soap,
mixed according to the manufacturer’s
instructions. Use a soft cotton mitt and
keep it wet by dipping it frequently into
the wash water. Do not rub hard—let
the soap and water remove the dirt.
Automatic car wash
Aluminum wheels: Use only a mild soap
or neutral detergent.
Plastic bumpers: Wash carefully. Do not
scrub with abrasive cleaners. The bumper
faces are soft.
Road tar: Remove with turpentine or
cleaners that are marked safe for painted
surfaces.
NOTICE
Do not use gasoline or strong solvents, which may be toxic or cause
damage.
Your vehicle may be washed in an automatic car wash, but remember that the
paint can be scratched by some type of
brushes, unfiltered washing water, or the
washing process itself. Scratching reduces
paint durability and gloss, especially on
darker colors. The manager of the car
wash should be able to advise you whether the process is safe for the paint on
your vehicle.
Waxing your Toyota
Polishing and waxing is recommended
to maintain the original beauty of your
Toyota’s finish.
Once a month or if the vehicle does not
repel water well, apply wax.
1. Always wash and dry the vehicle before you begin waxing, even if you are
using a combined cleaner and wax.
2. Use a good quality polish and wax. If
the finish has become extremely weathered, use a car–cleaning polish, followed by a separate wax. Carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and
precautions. Be sure to polish and wax
the chrome trim as well as the paint.
3. Wax the vehicle again when water
does not bead but remains on the surface in large patches.
NOTICE
Always remove the plastic bumpers if
your vehicle is re–painted and placed
in a high heat paint waxing booth.
High temperatures could damage the
bumpers.
3. Rinse
thoroughly—dried
soap
can
cause streaking. In hot weather you
may need to rinse each section right
after you wash it.
199
’99camry U
Cleaning the interior
CAUTION
Vehicles with side airbags:
Be careful not to splash water or
spill liquid on the floor. This may
prevent the side airbags from activating correctly, resulting in serious
injury
Do not wash the vehicle floor with
water, or allow water to get onto
the floor when cleaning the vehicle
interior or exterior. Water may get
into audio components or other
electrical components above or under the floor carpet (or mat) and
cause a malfunction; and it may
cause body corrosion.
Vinyl interior
The vinyl upholstery may be easily
cleaned with a mild soap or detergent
and water.
200
First vacuum over the upholstery to remove loose dirt. Then, using a sponge or
soft cloth, apply the soap solution to the
vinyl. After allowing it to soak in for a few
minutes to loosen the dirt, remove the dirt
and wipe off the soap with a clean damp
cloth. If all the dirt do not come off, repeat the procedure. Commercial foaming–
type vinyl cleaners are also available
which work well. Follow the manufacturer’s
instructions.
Do not apply water—the best results are
obtained by keeping the carpet as dry as
possible. Read the shampoo instructions
and follow them closely.
Seat belts
The seat belts may be cleaned with
mild soap and water or with lukewarm
water.
Use a cloth or sponge. As you are cleaning, check the belts for excessive wear,
fraying, or cuts.
NOTICE
Do not use solvent, thinner, gasoline
or window cleaner on the interior.
Carpets
Use a good foam–type
clean the carpets.
shampoo
to
Begin by vacuuming thoroughly to remove
as much dirt as possible. Several types of
foam cleaners are available; some are in
aerosol can sand others are powders or
liquids which you mix with water to produce a foam. To shampoo the carpets,
use a sponge or brush to apply the foam.
Rub in overlapping circles.
NOTICE
Do not use dye or bleach on the
belts—it may weaken them.
Do not use the belts until they become dry.
Windows
The windows may be cleaned with any
household window cleaner.
NOTICE
When cleaning the inside of the windows, be careful not to scratch or
damage the heater wires on the rear
window.
’99camry U
Air conditioning control panel, car audio, instrument panel, console panel,
and switches
Leather Interior
Use a soft damp cloth for cleaning.
Remove dirt using a soft cloth dampened
with 5% solution of neutral detergent for
wool. Then thoroughly wipe off all traces
of detergent with a clean damp cloth.
Soak a clean soft cloth in water or lukewarm water then lightly wipe off dirt.
NOTICE
Do not use organic substances (solvents, kerosene, alcohol, gasoline,
etc.) or alkaline or acidic solutions.
These chemicals can cause discoloring, staining or peeling of the
surface.
If you use cleaners or polishing
agents, make sure their ingredients
do not include the substances mentioned above.
If you use a liquid car freshener, do
not spill the liquid onto the vehicle’s interior surfaces. It may contain the ingredients mentioned above. Immediately clean any spill
using the method mentioned above.
The leather upholstery may be cleaned
with neutral detergent for wool.
After cleaning or whenever any part of the
leather gets wet, dry with a soft clean
cloth. Allow the leather to dry in a ventilated shaded area.
NOTICE
If a stain should fail to come out
with a neutral detergent, apply a
cleaner that does not contain an
organic solvent.
Never use organic substances such
as benzine, alcohol or gasoline, or
alkaline or acid solutions for cleaning
the
leather
as
these
could cause discoloring.
Use of a nylon brush or synthetic
fiber cloth, etc. may scratch the
fine grained surface of the leather.
Mildew may develop on soiled leather upholstery. Be especially careful
to avoid oil spots. Try to keep your
upholstery always clean.
Long exposure to direct sunlight
may cause the leather surface to
harden and shrink. Keep your vehicle in a shaded area, especially in
the summer.
The interior of your vehicle is apt
to heat up on hot summer days, so
avoid placing on the upholstery
items made of vinyl or plastic or
containing wax as these tend to
stick to leather when warm.
Improper cleaning of the leather upholstery could result in discoloration or staining.
If you have any questions about the
cleaning of your Toyota, your local
Toyota dealer will be pleased to answer
them.
201
’99camry U
202
’99camry U
Part 6
VEHICLE
MAINTENANCE
AND CARE
Maintenance requirements
General maintenance
Does your vehicle need
repairing?
Maintenance requirements
Your Toyota vehicle has been designed to
for fewer maintenance requirements with
longer service intervals to save both your
time and money. However, each regular
maintenance, as well as day–to–day care,
is more important than ever before to ensure smooth, trouble–free, safe, and economical drivings.
It is the owner’s responsibility to make
sure the specified maintenance, including
general maintenance service, is performed.
Note that both the new vehicle and emission control system warranties specify that
proper maintenance and care must be performed. See ”Owner’s Warranty Information Booklet” or ”Owner’s Manual Supplement”.
General maintenance
For scheduled maintenance information, please refer to the separate
”Scheduled Maintenance
Guide”
or ”Owner’s Manual Supplement”.
General maintenance items are those day–
to–day care practices that are important to
your vehicle for proper operation. It is the
owner’s responsibility to insure that the
general maintenance items are performed
regularly.
These checks or inspections can be done
either by yourself or a qualified technician,
or if you prefer, your Toyota dealer will be
pleased to do them at a nominal cost.
Scheduled maintenance
The scheduled maintenance items listed in
the ”Scheduled Maintenance Guide” or
”Owner’s Manual Supplement” are those
required to be serviced at regular intervals.
For details of your maintenance schedule,
read the separate ”Scheduled Maintenance
Guide” or ”Owner’s Manual Supplement”.
It is recommended that any replacement
parts used for maintenance or for the
repair of the emission control system
be Toyota supplied.
The owner may elect to use non–Toyota
supplied parts for replacement purposes without invalidating the emission
control system warranty. However, use
of replacement parts which are not of
equivalent quality may impair the effectiveness of the emission control systems.
You may also elect to have maintenance, replacement, or repair of the
emission control devices and system
performed by any automotive repair establishment or individual without invalidating this warranty. See ”Owner’s Warranty Information Booklet” or ”Owner’s
Manual Supplement” for complete warranty information.
203
’99camry U
General maintenance
Where to go for service?
Toyota technicians are well–trained specialists and are kept up to date with the
latest service information through technical
bulletins, service tips, and in–dealership
training programs. They learn to work on
Toyotas before they work on your vehicle,
rather than while they are working on it.
You can be confident that your Toyota
dealer’s service department performs the
best job to meet the maintenance requirements on your vehicle—reliably and economically.
Your copy of the repair order is proof that
all required maintenance has been performed for warranty coverage. And if any
problems should arise with your vehicle
while under warranty, your Toyota dealer
will promptly take care of it. Again, be
sure to keep a copy of the repair order
for any service performed on your Toyota.
What about do–it–yourself maintenance?
Many of the maintenance items are easy
to do yourself if you have a little mechanical ability and a few basic automotive
tools. Simple instructions for how to perform them are presented in Part 7.
204
If you are a skilled do–it–yourself mechanic, the Toyota service manuals are recommended. Please be aware that do–it–yourself maintenance can affect your warranty
coverage. See ”Owner’s Warranty Information Booklet” or ”Owner’s Manual Supplement” for the details.
Listed below are the general maintenance
items that should be performed as frequently as specified. In addition to checking the items listed, if you notice any
unusual noise, smell or vibration, you
should investigate the cause or take your
vehicle to your Toyota dealer or a qualified service shop immediately. It is recommended that any problem you notice be
brought to the attention of your dealer or
the qualified service shop for their advice.
CAUTION
Make these checks only where adequate ventilation can be obtained if
you run the engine.
OUTSIDE THE VEHICLE
Items listed below should be performed
from time to time, unless otherwise
specified.
Tire pressure
Check the pressure with a gauge every
two weeks, or at least once a month. See
Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
’99camry U
Tire surface and wheel nuts
Check the tires carefully for cuts, damage
or excessive wear. See Chapter 7–2 for
additional information. When checking the
tires, make sure no nuts are missing, and
check the nuts for looseness. Tighten
them if necessary.
Tire rotation
Rotate the tires every 12000 km (7500
miles). See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Fluid leaks
Check underneath for leaking fuel, oil, water or other fluid after the vehicle has
been parked for a while. If you smell fuel
fumes or notice any leak, have the cause
found and corrected immediately.
Doors and engine hood
Check that all doors including trunk lid
operate smoothly and all latches lock securely. Make sure the engine hood secondary latch secures the hood from opening when the primary latch is released.
INSIDE THE VEHICLE
Items listed below should be checked
regularly, e.g. while performing periodic
services, cleaning the vehicle, etc.
Lights
Make sure the headlights, stop lights, tail
lights, turn signal lights, and other lights
are all working. Check headlight aim.
Service reminder indicators and warning
buzzers
Check that all service reminder indicators
and warning buzzers function properly.
Steering wheel
Be alert for changes in steering condition,
such as hard steering or strange noise.
Seats
Check that all front seat controls such as
seat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc. operate smoothly and that all latches lock
securely in any position. Check that the
head restraints move up and down
smoothly and that the locks hold securely
in any latched position. For folding–down
rear seatbacks, check that the latches
lock securely.
Seat belts
Check that the seat belt system such as
buckles, retractors and anchors operate
properly and smoothly. Make sure that the
belt webbings not cut, frayed, worn or
damaged.
Accelerator pedal
Check the pedal for smooth operation and
uneven pedal effort or catching.
Clutch pedal
Check the pedal for smooth operation.
Brake pedal
Check the pedal for smooth operation and
that the pedal has the proper clearance.
Check the brake booster function.
Brakes
At a safe place, check that the brakes do
not pull to one side when applied.
Parking brake
Check that the lever has the proper travel
and that, on a safe incline, your vehicle
is held securely with only the parking
brake applied.
Automatic transmission ”Park” mechanism
Check the lock release button of the selector lever for proper and smooth operation. On a safe incline, check that your
vehicle is held securely with the selector
lever in ”P” position and all brakes released.
205
’99camry U
Does your vehicle need
repairing?
IN THE ENGINE COMPARTMENT
Items listed below should be checked
from time to time, e.g. each time when
refueling.
Washer fluid
Make sure there is sufficient fluid in the
tank. See Chapter 7–3 for additional information.
Engine coolant level
Make sure the coolant level is between
the ”FULL” and ”LOW” lines on the see–
through reservoir when the engine is cold.
See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Battery electrolyte level
Make sure the electrolyte level of all battery cells is between upper and lower level lines on the case. Add only distilled
water when replenishing. See Chapter 7–3
for additional information.
Brake fluid level
Make sure the brake fluid level is correct.
See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Engine oil level
Check the level on the dipstick with the
engine turned off and the vehicle parked
on a level spot. See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Power steering fluid level
Check the level through the reservoir. The
level should be in the ”HOT” or ”COLD”
range depending on the fluid temperature.
See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Exhaust system
If you notice any change in the sound of
the exhaust or smell exhaust fumes, have
the cause located and corrected immediately. (See engine exhaust cautions in
Part 2.)
Be on the alert for changes in performance, sounds, and visual tip–offs that
indicate service is needed. Some important clues are as follows:
Engine missing, stumbling, or pinging
Appreciable loss of power
Strange engine noises
A leak under the vehicle (however, water dripping from the air conditioning
after use is normal.)
Change in exhaust sound (This may
indicate a dangerous carbon monoxide
leak. Drive with the windows open and
have the exhaust system checked immediately.)
Flat–looking tire; excessive tire squeal
when cornering; uneven tire wear
Vehicle pulls to one side when driving
straight on a level road
Strange noises related to suspension
movement
Loss of brake effectiveness; spongy
feeling brake or clutch pedal;pedal almost touches floor; vehicle pulls to one
side when braking
Engine coolant temperature continually
higher than normal
206
’99camry U
If you notice any of these clues, take your
vehicle to your Toyota dealer as soon as
possible. It probably needs adjustment or
repair.
CAUTION
Do not continue driving with the vehicle unchecked. It could result in serious vehicle damage and possibly
personal injury.
207
’99camry U
208
’99camry U
Part 8
SPECIFICATIONS
Dimensions and weight
P195/70R14 tire
P205/65R15 tire
Overall length
mm (in.)
4783 (188.3)
4783 (188.3)
Overall width
mm (in.)
1780
(70.1)
1780
(70.1)
Overall height
mm (in.)
1416
(55.7)∗
1419
(55.9)∗
Service specifications
Wheelbase
mm (in.)
2670 (105.1)
2670 (105.1)
Tires
Front tread
mm (in.)
1547
(61.0)
1547
(61.0)
Fuses
Rear tread
mm (in.)
1520
(59.8)
1520
(59.8)
410
(900)
410
(900)
Dimensions and weight
Engine
Fuel
Vehicle capacity weight
(occupants + luggage) kg (lb)
∗:
Unladen vehicle
239
’99camry U
Engine
Fuel
Service specifications
Model:
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE
Fuel type:
5S–FE engine
Unleaded gasoline, Octane Rating 87
(Research Octane Number 91) or higher
ENGINE
Type:
5S–FE engine
4 cylinder in line, 4 cycle, gasoline
1MZ–FE engine
6 cylinder V type 4 cycle, gasoline
Bore and stroke, mm (in.):
5S–FE engine
87.0 91.0 (3.43 3.58)
1MZ–FE engine
87.5 83.0 (3.44 3.27)
Displacement, cm3 (cu. in.):
5S–FE engine
2164 (132.0)
1MZ–FE engine
2995 (182.8)
1MZ–FE engine
Unleaded gasoline, Octane Rating 87
(Research Octane Number 91) or higher.
For improved vehicle performance, the
use of premium unleaded gasoline with
an Octane Rating of 91 (Research Octane Number 96) or higher is recommended.
Fuel tank capacity, L (gal., Imp. gal.):
70 (18.5, 15.4)
Valve clearance (engine cold), mm (in.):
5S–FE engine
Intake
0.19—0.29 (0.007—0.011)
Exhaust
0.28—0.38 (0.011—0.015)
1MZ–FE engine
Intake
0.15—0.25 (0.006—0.010)
Exhaust
0.25—0.35 (0.010—0.014)
Spark plug type:
DENSO
NGK
Spark plug gap, mm(in.):
1.1 (0.043)
Drive belt tension measured with Borroughs
drive belt tension gauge No.BT–33–73F
(used belt), Ibf:
5S–FE engine
With air conditioning
Generator belt
Power steering pump belt
Without air conditioning
Generator belt
Power steering pump belt
1MZ–FE engine
240
PK20TR11
BKR6EKPB11
13010
8020
6520
8020
11520
’99camry U
ENGINE LUBRICATION
COOLING SYSTEM
CLUTCH
Oil capacity (drain and refill), L (qt., Imp.
qt.):
Total capacity, L (qt., Imp. qt.):
5S–FE engine
6.9 (7.3, 6.1)
1MZ–FE engine
9.1 (9.6, 8.4)
Pedal freeplay, mm (in.):
5—15 (0.2—0.6)
5S–FE engine
With filter
Without filter
1MZ–FE engine
With filter
Without filter
3.6 (3.8, 3.2)
3.4 (3.6, 3.0)
Coolant type:
4.7 (5.0, 4.1)
4.5 (4.8, 4.0)
Oil grade:
API grade SJ, ”Energy–Conserving” or
ILSAC multigrade engine oil is recommended.
Recommended oil viscosity (SAE):
”Toyota Long Life Coolant” or equivalent
MANUAL TRANSAXLE
With ethylene–glycol type coolant for a
proper corrosion protection of aluminum
components
Oil capacity, L (qt., Imp. qt.):
5S–FE engine
2.2 (2.3, 1.9)
1MZ–FE engine
4.2 (4.4, 3.7)
Do not use alcohol type antifreeze or
plain water alone.
Oil type:
Gear oil API GL–4 or GL–5
BATTERY
Open voltage∗ at 20C (68F):
12.6—12.8V Fully charged
12.2—12.4V Half charged
11.8—12.0V Discharged
∗:
Fluid type:
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3
Voltage that is checked 20 minutes after
the key is removed with all the lights
turned off
Charging rates:
5 A max.
Recommended oil viscosity:
SAE 75W–90
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
1MZ–FE engine
Fluid capacity (drain and refill),
L (qt., Imp. qt.):
Up to 4.75 (5.0, 4.2)
Fluid type:
Automatic transmission fluid D–ll or
DEXRONIIl (DEXRONII)
241
’99camry U
5S–FE engine
Automatic transmission
Fluid capacity (drain and refill),
L (qt., Imp. qt.):
Up to 2.5 (2.6, 2.2)
Fluid type:
Automatic transmission fluid D–ll or
DEXRONIIl (DEXRONII)
Differential
Fluid capacity L (qt., Imp. qt.):
1.6 (1.7, 1.4)
Fluid type:
Automatic transmission fluid D–II or
DEXRONIII (DEXRONII)
BRAKES
Minimum pedal clearance when depressed
with the pressure of 490 N (50 kgf, 110 lbf)
with the engine running, mm (in.):
70 (2.8)
Pedal freeplay, mm (in.):
1—6 (0.04—0.24)
Pad wear limit, mm (in.):
1.0 (0.04)
Lining wear limit, mm (in.):
1.0 (0.04)
Parking brake adjustment when pulled with
the force of 196 N (20 kgf, 44 lbf):
5—8 clicks
242
Fluid type:
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3
STEERING
Wheel freeplay:
Less than 30 mm (1.2 in.)
Power steering fluid type:
Automatic transmission fluid DEXRONII
or III
’99camry U
Tires
Normal driving
kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi)
For all loads including full rated loads
Tire size
For reduced loads (1 to 4 passengers)
Wheel size
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
P195/70R14 90S
210 (2.1, 30)
210 (2.1, 30)
210 (2.1, 30)
210 (2.1, 30)
145.5JJ
P205/65R15 92H
220 (2.2, 32)
220 (2.2, 32)
200 (2.0, 29)
200 (2.0, 29)
156JJ
Trailer driving
kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi)
Tire size
Front
Rear
P195/70R14 90S
210 (2.1, 30)
210 (2.1, 30)
P205/65R15 92H
220 (2.2, 32)
220 (2.2, 32)
When driving under the above vehicle load conditions at sustained high speeds above 160 km/h (100 mph), in countries where such
speeds are permitted by–law, inflate the front and rear tires to 240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2 or bar, 35 psi) provided that it dose not exceed
the maximum cold tire pressure molded on the tire sidewall.
Wheel nut torque, N·m (kgf·m, ft·lbf):
104 (10.5, 77)
243
’99camry U
Fuses
Engine compartment
Engine compartment (type A)
Fuses (type A)
8. HORN 10 A: Horn, theft deterrent system
1. A/C 10 A: Air conditioning system
2. SPARE 10 A: Spare fuse
3. SPARE 15 A: Spare fuse
4. SPARE 30 A: Spare fuse
5. ALT–S 5 A: Charging system
6. HEAD RH(UPR) (with daytime running light system) or HEAD (RH)
(without daytime running light system) 15 A: Right–hand headlight
Engine compartment
244
7. EFI 15 A: Multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection
system
9. HAZARD 10 A: Emergency flasher
10. AM2 30 A: Gauge and meter, SRS
airbag system, seat belt pretensioners,
Multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system,
”IGN” and ”ST” fuses
11. TEL 5 A: No circuit
12. HEAD LH(UPR) (with daytime running light system) or HEAD (LH)
(without daytime running light system) 15 A: Left–hand headlight
13. RADIO NO.1 20 A: Audio system
’99camry U
22. GAUGE 10 A: Gauges and meters,
back–up lights, cruise control system,
charging system, traction control system, daytime running light system,
power windows, service reminder indicators and warning buzzers
23. WIPER 25 A: Windshield wipers and
washer
24. MIRROR–HEATER 10 A: Outside rear
view mirror defogger
Engine compartment (type B)
14. DOME 7.5 A: Theft deterrent system,
daytime running light system, clock,
locking with wireless remote control
system, ignition switch light, personal
light, trunk light, electric moon roof
lamp, interior light, vanity mirror light,
door courtesy light, power door lock
system
15. ECU–B 10 A: Cruise control system,
anti–lock brake system, SRS airbag
system, seat belt pretensioners
Instrument panel
17. H–LP LH(LWR) 10 A: Left–hand headlight
18. H–LP RH(LWR)
headlight
10
A:
Right–hand
19. A/F HTR 25 A: A/F sensor
20. SEAT–HEATER 20 A: No circuit
21. HEATER 10 A: Air conditioning system,
rear window defogger, starting system
25. ECU–IG 15 A: Cruise control system,
anti–lock brake system, power antenna,
SRS airbag system, seat belt pretensioners, theft deterrent system, shift
lock control system, traction control
system, daytime running light system,
locking with wireless remote control
system, multiport fuel injection system/
sequential multiport fuel injection system
26. IGN 5 A: Gauges and meters, charging
system, SRS airbag system, seat belt
pretensioners, multiport fuel injection
system/sequential multiport fuel injection system
16. DRL NO.2 5 A: Daytime running light
system
245
’99camry U
27. STOP 15 A: Stop lights, cruise control
system, high–mounted stoplight, anti–
lock brake system, shift lock control
system, multiport fuel injection system/
sequential multiport fuel injection system
28. TAIL 10 A: Parking lights, license plate
lights, tail lights, front side marker
lights, daytime running light system,
multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system
29. POWER–OUTLET 15 A: Power outlet
30. OBD 7.5 A: On–board diagnosis system
31. FOG 15 A: No circuit
32. STARTER 5 A: Gauges and meters,
Multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system
33. DOOR 25 A: Power door lock system,
theft deterrent system, fuel filler door
control system
34. PANEL 7.5 A: Gauge and meter, audio
system, cigarette lighter, glove box
light, clock, instrument panel light control, service reminder indicators, air
conditioning control panel lights, ashtray light, emergency flasher, seat heater control system, daytime running light
system, rear window defogger, electronically controlled automatic transmission
system
35. TURN 7.5 A: Emergency flasher
36. RAD–NO.2 7.5 A: Audio system, power
antenna
37. CIG 15 A: Cigarette lighter, shift lock
control system, power rear view mirror
controls, theft deterrent system, power
door lock system, SRS airbag system,
seat belt pretensioners, outside rear
view mirror defogger, air conditioning
system
Fuses (type B)
38. CDS 30 A: Electric cooling fans
39. RDI 30 A: Electric cooling fans
40. MAIN 40 A: ”HEAD RH(UPR)”, ”HEAD
RH”, ”H–LP RH(LWR)” fuses
41. HTR 50 A: ”AM1”, ”A/C” fuses
42. DEF 40 A: Rear window defogger
246
43. PWR 30 A: Power window control system, power seat, electric moon roof
44. AM1 40 A: Head lamp cleaner
45. T–STK 40 A or CDS NO.2 30 A: No
Circuit
Fuses (type C)
46. ALT 100 A: ”RDI”, ”CDS” fuses
47. ABS 60 A: Anti–lock brake system
’99camry U
Part 9
REPORTING SAFETY
DEFECTS FOR U.S.
OWNERS AND
UNIFORM TIRE
QUALITY GRADING
Reporting safety defects for U.S.
owners
Uniform tire quality grading
Reporting safety defects
for U.S. owners
If you believe that your vehicle has
a defect which could cause a crash
or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying Toyota Motor Sales,
U.S.A., Inc.
(Toll–free: 1–800–331–4331).
To contact NHTSA, you may either
call the Auto Safety Hotline toll–free
at 1–800–424–9393 (or 366–0123 in
Washington,D.C. area) or write to:
NHTSA. U.S.Department of Transportation. Washington,D.C. 20590.
You can also obtain other information
about motor vehicle safety from the
Hotline.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it
may order a recall and remedy
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot
become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or
Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc.
247
’99camry U
Uniform tire quality grading
This information has been prepared in accordance with regulations issued by the
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration of the U.S. Department of Transportation. It provides the purchasers and/
or prospective purchasers of Toyota
vehicles with information on uniform tire
quality grading.
Traction AA, A, B, C—The traction
grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A,
B, and C, and they represent the tire’s
ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt
and concrete. A tire marked C may have
poor traction performance.
Your Toyota dealer will help answer any
questions you may have as you read this
information.
Warning: The traction grade assigned to
this tire is based on braking (straight
ahead) traction tests and does not include
cornering (turning) traction.
DOT quality grades—All passenger vehicle tires must conform to Federal
Safety Requirements in addition to
these grades. These quality grades are
molded on the sidewall.
Treadwear—The treadwear grade is a
comparative rating based on the wear rate
of the tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government test
course. For example, a tire graded 150
would wear one and a half (1–1/2) times
as well on the government course as a
tire graded 100. The relative performance
of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to
variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.
248
Temperature A, B, C—The temperature
grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature
can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car
tires must meet under the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades
B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than
the minimum required by law.
Warning: The temperature grades for this
tire are established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive
loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible
tire failure.
’99camry U
Part 10
INDEX
249
’99camry CNG
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–1
Overview of instruments
and controls
Instrument panel overview
Instrument cluster overview
Indicator symbols on the
instrument panel
Instrument panel overview
1. Side defroster outlets
2. Side vents
3. Instrument cluster
4. Center vents
i
’99camry CNG
5. Glove box
6. Garage door opener box or
miscellaneous box
7. Power door lock switches
8. Power window switches
9. Cup holders
10. Cup holder or rear ashtray
11. Parking brake lever
12. Automatic transmission selector lever
13. Auxiliary box
14. Hood lock release lever
15. Window lock switch
1. Power rear view mirror control switch
2. Headlight and turn signal switch
3. Wiper and washer switches
4. Clock
5. Emergency flasher switch
6. Car audio
7. Rear window and outside rear view
mirror defoggers switch
8. Air conditioning controls
ii
’99camry CNG
9. Front ashtray
10. Power outlet
11. Cigarette lighter
12. Ignition switch
13. Cruise control switch
14. Tilt steering lock release lever
15. Instrument panel light control knob
iii
’99camry CNG
Instrument cluster overview
1. Engine coolant temperature gauge
2. Service reminder indicators and
indicator lights
3. Fuel gauge
4. Speedometer
5. Odometer and two trip meters
6. Tachometer
7. Trip meter reset knob
iv
’99camry CNG
8. Low fuel level warning light
v
’99camry CNG
Indicator symbols on the instrument panel
Brake system warning light∗1
Low windshield washer fluid level warning light∗1
Seat belt reminder light∗1
Turn signal indicator lights
Discharge warning light∗1
Headlight high beam indicator light
Malfunction indicator lamp∗1
Overdrive–off indicator light
Low oil pressure warning light∗1
Cruise control indicator light∗2
Anti–lock brake system warning light∗1
Automatic transmission indicator lights
Open door warning light∗1
∗1 :
∗2 :
For details, see “Service reminder indicators and warning
buzzers” in Chapter 1–5.
If this light flashes, see “Cruise control” in Chapter 1–6.
Rear light failure warning light∗1
SRS warning light∗1
vi
’99camry CNG
vii
’99camry CNG
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–2
Keys and Doors
Keys
Side doors
Power windows
Trunk lid
Hood
Refueling
Keys
viii
’99camry CNG
Your vehicle is supplied with two kinds of key.
1. Master key—This key works in every lock.
2. Sub key—This key will not work in the glove box and trunk.
To protect things locked in the glove box or trunk when you have your vehicle
parked, leave the sub key with the attendant.
Since the doors and trunk lid can be locked without a key, you should always carry
a spare master key in case you accidentally lock your keys inside the vehicle.
ix
’99camry CNG
KEY NUMBER PLATE
Your key number is shown on the plate. Keep the plate in a safe place such
as your wallet, not in the vehicle.
If you should lose your keys or if you need additional keys, duplicates can be made
by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer using the key number.
We recommend you to write down the key number and keep it in safe place.
Side doors
x
’99camry CNG
LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITH KEY
Insert the key into the keyhole and turn it.
To lock: Turn the key forward.
To unlock: Turn the key backward.
All the doors lock and unlock simultaneously with either front door. In the driver’s
door lock, turning the key once will unlock the driver’s door and twice in succession
will unlock all the doors simultaneously.
xi
’99camry CNG
LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK BUTTON
Move the lock button.
To lock: Push the knob forward.
To unlock: Pull the knob backward.
Closing the door with the lock knob in the lock position will also lock the door. Be
careful not to lock your keys in the vehicle.
The door cannot be locked if you leave the key in the ignition switch.
xii
’99camry CNG
Driver’s side
Passenger’s side
xiii
’99camry CNG
LOCKING AND UNLOCKING WITH POWER DOOR LOCK SWITCH
Push the switch.
To lock: Push the switch on the front side.
To unlock: Push the switch on the rear side.
All the doors lock or unlock simultaneously.
REAR DOOR CHILD–PROTECTORS
Move the lock lever to the “LOCK” position as shown on the label.
This feature allows you to lock a rear door so it can be opened from the outside
only, not from inside. We recommend using this feature whenever small children are
in the vehicle.
xiv
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Before driving, be sure that the doors are closed and locked, especially
when small children are in the vehicle. Along with the proper use of seat
belts, locking the doors helps prevent the driver and passengers from being
thrown out from the vehicle during an accident. It also helps prevent the
doors from being opened unintentionally.
Power windows
The windows can be operated with the switch on each door.
The power windows work when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
Key off operation: If both front doors are closed, they work for 45 seconds even
after the ignition switch is turned off. They stop working when either front door is
opened.
OPERATING THE DRIVER’S WINDOW
xv
’99camry CNG
Use the switch on the driver’s door.
Normal operation: The window moves as long as you hold the switch.
To open: Lightly push down the switch.
To close: Pull up the switch.
Automatic operation (to open only): Push the switch completely down and then
release it. The window will fully open. To stop the window partway, lightly pull the
switch up and then release it.
xvi
’99camry CNG
Window
lock
switch
OPERATING THE PASSENGERS’ WINDOWS
Use the switches on the passengers’ doors. The driver’s door also has
switches that control the passengers’ windows.
The window moves as long as you hold the switch.
To open: Push down the switch.
To close: Pull up the switch.
If you push in the window lock switch on the driver’s door, the passengers’ windows
cannot be operated.
xvii
’99camry CNG
xviii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
To avoid serious personal injury, you must do the following.
Always make sure the head, hands and other parts of the body of all
occupants are kept completely inside the vehicle before you close the
power windows. If someone’s neck, head or hands gets caught in a closing
window, it could result in a serious injury. When anyone closes the power
windows, be sure that they operate the windows safely.
When small children are in the vehicle, never let them use the power
window switches without supervision. Use the window lock switch to prevent them from making unexpected use of the switches.
Never leave small children alone in the vehicle, especially with the ignition
key still inserted. They could use the power window switches and get
trapped in a window. Unattended children can become involved in serious
accidents.
Trunk lid—
xix
’99camry CNG
To open the trunk lid from the outside, insert the master key and turn it
clockwise.
See “Luggage stowage precautions” in Part 2 for precautions to observe for loading
luggage.
To close the trunk lid, lower it and press down on it. After closing the trunk lid,
try pulling it up to make sure it is securely closed.
CAUTION
Keep the trunk lid closed while driving. This not only keeps the luggage
from being thrown out but also prevents exhaust gases from entering the
vehicle.
—Lock release lever
xx
’99camry CNG
To open the trunk lid from the driver’s seat, pull up on the lock release lever.
—Luggage security system
xxi
’99camry CNG
This system deactivates the lock release lever so that things locked in the
trunk can be protected.
After closing the trunk lid, insert the master key and turn it counterclockwise
to deactivate the lock release lever.
After closing the trunk lid, try pulling it up to make sure it is securely locked.
Hood
To open the hood:
1. Pull the hood lock release lever. The hood will spring up slightly.
CAUTION
Before driving, be sure that the hood is closed and securely locked. Otherwise, the hood may open unexpectedly while driving and an accident may
occur.
xxii
’99camry CNG
2. In front of the vehicle, pull up the auxiliary catch lever and lift the hood.
xxiii
’99camry CNG
Refueling—
3. Hold the hood
open by inserting the support rod into the slot.
—Refueling
precaution
Before closing the hood, check to see that you have not forgotten any tools, rags,
etc. and return the support rod to its clip—this prevents rattles. Then lower the
hood make sure it locks into place. If necessary, press down gently on the front
edge to lock it.
CAUTION
After inserting the support rod into the slot, make sure the rod supports the
hood securely from falling down on to your head or body.
When refueling, you must
NGV–1–1994 standards.
use
a
special
nozzle
that
meets
ANSI/AGA
There are three types of nozzles. Use a P36 type nozzle for this vehicle. If
a P36 nozzle is not available at a nearby CNG station, you may use another
type of nozzle, but you cannot expect to get a completely full tank with it.
For your safety, ask and follow the instructions at the refueling station when
refueling.
Before starting to refuel, wipe off mud or dirt that may be deposited around
the fuel receptacle.
You will hear a chattering noise from the tank when it is being filled, but this is
quite normal.
If you hear fuel leaking from the fuel receptacle, stop refueling immediately and
have your authorized Toyota CNG dealer check the fuel receptacle.
For information on CNG stations, refer to the station “Refueling station information”
on page iii in the beginning of this manual.
xxiv
’99camry CNG
—Refueling method
(high speed refueling)
CAUTION
In order to safety refuel and avoid serious personal injury, ask the CNG
station staff to refuel the vehicle with CNG for you.
Do not start the engine while refueling. As the natural gas is flammable,
an explosion or a fire could occur. Also, do not smoke or allow open
flames when refueling.
If you smell or hear fuel leaking while refueling, immediately stop refueling. Do not refuel it until after the leak has been repaired.
There are two ways of natural gas refueling: high and low speed. This manual
explains typical high speed refueling.
As for the low speed refueling method, follow the instructions provided by the
manufacturer for the refueling equipments.
xxv
’99camry CNG
1. To open the refueling plug door, pull the lever up.
When refueling, turn off the engine.
2. Remove the rubber cap.
Check there is no mud or dirt around the fuel receptacle.
xxvi
’99camry CNG
3. Fit the filling nozzle securely on the fuel receptacle.
There are various types of filling nozzles so follow the instructions at each CNG
station.
xxvii
’99camry CNG
4. Turn the valve lever to fasten the nozzle to the fuel receptacle and to start
filling the tank.
5. Refueling will stop automatically when the tank is full. When disconnecting
the filling nozzle, follow the instructions of the refueling station.
Reverse the procedure to disconnect the nozzle after filling the tank.
When disconnecting the filling nozzle, you may hear a brief hissing sound as a
small amount of fuel escapes, but this is normal.
xxviii
’99camry CNG
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–3
Seats, Seat belts,
Steering wheel and
Mirrors
Seats
Front seats
Head restraints
Seat belts
SRS driver and front passenger
airbags
Child restraint
Tilt steering wheel
Outside rear view mirrors
Anti–glare inside rear view
mirror
xxix
’99camry CNG
Front seats—
—Seat adjustment
precautions
Sun visors
Seats
While the vehicle is being driven, all vehicle occupants should have the seatback
upright, sit well back in the seat and properly wear the seat belts provided.
CAUTION
Do not drive the vehicle unless the occupants are properly seated. Do not
allow sitting on top of a folded–down seatback, or in the luggage compartment. Persons not properly seated and not properly restrained by seat
belts can be severely injured in the event of emergency braking or a
collision.
During driving, do not allow passengers to stand up or move around
between seats. Severe injuries can occur in the event of emergency braking or a collision.
Adjust the driver’s seat so that the foot pedals, steering wheel and instrument panel
controls are within easy reach of the driver.
xxx
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Adjustments should not be made while the vehicle is moving, as the seat
may unexpectedly move and cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle.
When adjusting the seat, be careful not to hit the seat against a passenger
or luggage.
After adjusting the seat position, try sliding it forward and backward to
make sure it is locked in position.
After adjusting the seatback, exert body pressure to make sure it is locked
in position.
Do not put objects under the seats. The objects may interfere with the
seat–lock mechanism or unexpectedly push up the seat position adjusting
lever; the seat may suddenly move, causing the driver to lose control of
the vehicle.
While adjusting the seat, do not put your hands under the seat or near
the moving parts. You may catch and injure your hands or fingers.
—Adjusting front seats
xxxi
’99camry CNG
1. SEAT POSITION ADJUSTING LEVER
xxxii
’99camry CNG
Pull the lever up. Then slide the seat to the desired position with slight body
pressure and release the lever.
2. SEATBACK ANGLE ADJUSTING LEVER
Lean forward and pull the lever up. Then lean back to the desired angle and
release the lever.
CAUTION
To reduce the risk of sliding under the lap belt during a collision, avoid
reclining the seatback any more than needed. The seat belts provide maximum protection in a frontal or rear collision when the driver and the passenger are sitting up straight and well back in the seats. If you are reclined,
the lap belt may slide past your hips and apply restraint forces directly to
the abdomen. Therefore, in the event of a frontal collision, the risk of
personal injury may increase with increasing recline of the seatback.
3. SEAT CUSHION HEIGHT ADJUSTING KNOB
Turn the knob either way.
Head restraints
xxxiii
’99camry CNG
Front
Rear
xxxiv
’99camry CNG
Seat belts—
—Seat belt precautions
For your safety and comfort, adjust the head restraint before driving.
To raise: Pull it up.
To lower: Push it down while pressing the lock release button.
Front head restraint only—You can also move the head restraint forward or backward. If such adjustment is desired, pull or push on the top of the head restraint.
The head restraint is most effective when it is close to your head. Therefore, using
a cushion on the seatback is not recommended.
CAUTION
Adjust the center of the head restraint so that it is closest to the top of
your ears.
After adjusting the head restraint, make sure it is locked in position.
Do not drive with the head restraints removed.
Toyota strongly urges that the driver and passengers in the vehicle be properly
restrained at all times with the seat belts provided. Failure to do so could increase
the chance of injury and/or the severity of injury in accidents.
Child. Use a child restraint system appropriate for the child until the child becomes
large enough to properly wear the vehicle’s seat belts. See “Child restraint” for
details.
If a child is too large for a child restraint system, the child should sit in the rear
seat and must be restrained using the vehicle’s seat belt. According to accident
statistics, the child is safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than in the
front seat.
xxxv
’99camry CNG
If a child must sit in the front seat, the seat belts should be worn properly. If an
accident occurs and the seat belts are not worn properly, the force of the rapid
inflation of the airbag may cause death or serious injury to the child.
Do not allow the child to stand up or kneel on either rear or front seats. An
unrestrained child could suffer serious injury or death during emergency braking or
a collision. Also, do not let the child sit on your lap. It does not provide sufficient
restraint.
Pregnant woman. Toyota recommends the use of a seat belt. Ask your doctor for
specific recommendations. The lap belt should be worn securely and as low as
possible over the hips and not on the waist.
Injured person. Toyota recommends the use of a seat belt. Depending on the
injury, first check with your doctor for specific recommendations.
xxxvi
’99camry CNG
—Front seat belts and rear
outside seat belts
CAUTION
Persons should ride in their seats properly wearing their seat belts whenever
the vehicle is moving. Otherwise, they are much more likely to suffer serious
bodily injury or death in the event of sudden braking or a collision.
When using the seat belts, observe the following:
Use the belt for only one person at a time. Do not use a single belt for
two or more people—even children.
Avoid reclining the seatbacks too much. The seat belts provide maximum
protection when the seatbacks are in the upright position. (Refer to the
seat adjustment instructions.)
Be careful not to damage the belt webbing or hardware. Take care that
they do not get caught or pinched in the seat or doors.
Inspect the belt system periodically. Check for cuts, fraying, and loose
parts. Damaged parts should be replaced. Do not disassemble or modify
the system.
Keep the belts clean and dry. If they need cleaning, use a mild soap
solution or lukewarm water. Never use bleach, dye, or abrasive cleaners—they may severely weaken the belts. (See “Cleaning the interior” in
Part 5.)
Replace the belt assembly (including bolts) if it has been used in a severe
impact. The entire assembly should be replaced even if damage is not
obvious.
xxxvii
’99camry CNG
Adjust the seat as needed (front seats only) and sit up straight and well back
in the seat. To fasten your belt, pull it out of the retractor and insert the tab
into the buckle.
You will hear a click when the tab locks into the buckle.
The seat belt length automatically adjusts to your size and the seat position.
The retractor will lock the belt during a sudden stop or on impact. It also may lock
if you lean forward too quickly. A slow, easy motion will allow the belt to extend,
and you can move around freely.
If the seat belt cannot be pulled out of the retractor, firmly pull the belt and release
it. You will then be able to smoothly pull the belt out of the retractor.
When a passenger’s shoulder belt is completely extended and is then retracted even
slightly, the belt is locked in that position and cannot be extended. This feature is
used to hold the child restraint system securely. (For details, see “Child restraint”
in this chapter.) To free the belt again, fully retract the belt and then pull the belt
out once more.
xxxviii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure the tab and buckle are locked and that
the belt is not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may prevent you from
properly latching the tab and buckle.
If the seat belt does not function normally, immediately contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer. Do not use the seat until the seat belt is fixed.
It cannot protect an adult occupant or your child from injury.
Seat belts with an adjustable shoulder anchor—
Adjust the shoulder anchor position to your size.
To raise: Slide the anchor up.
To lower: Push in the lock release button and slide the anchor down.
xxxix
’99camry CNG
After adjustment make sure the anchor is locked in position.
CAUTION
Always make sure the shoulder belt is positioned across the center of your
shoulder. The belt should be kept away from your neck, but not falling off
your shoulder. Failure to do so could reduce the amount of protection in an
accident and cause serious injures in a collision.
Take up
slack
Too high
Keep as low on
hips as possible
Adjust the position of the lap and shoulder belts.
Position the lap belt as low as possible on your hips—not on your waist, then adjust
it to a snug fit by pulling the shoulder portion upward through the latch plate.
xl
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
High–positioned lap belts and loose–fitting belts both could cause serious
injuries due to sliding under the lap belt during a collision or other
unintended result. Keep the lap belt positioned as low on hips as possible.
For your safety, do not place the shoulder belt under your arm.
To release the belt, press the buckle–release button and allow the belt to
retract.
If the belt does not retract smoothly, pull it out and check for kinks or twists. Then
make sure it remains untwisted as it retracts.
—Rear center seat belt
xli
’99camry CNG
Lengthen
Sit up straight and well back in the seat. To fasten your belt, insert the tab
into the buckle.
You will hear a click when the tab locks into the buckle.
If the belt is not long enough for you, hold the tab at a right angle to the belt and
pull on the tab.
xlii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure the tab and buckle are locked and that
the belt is not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may prevent you from
properly latching the tab and buckle.
If the seat belt does not function normally, immediately contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer. Do not use the seat until the seat belt is fixed.
It cannot protect an adult occupant or your child from injury.
Too high
Adjust to
a snug fit
Keep as low on hips as possible
Remove excess length of the belt and adjust the belt position.
To shorten the belt, pull the free end of the belt.
Position the lap belt as low as possible on your hips—not on your waist, then adjust
it to a snug fit.
xliii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
High–positioned and loose–fitting lap belts could cause serious injuries due
to sliding under the lap belt during a collision or other unintended result.
Keep the lap belt positioned as low on hips as possible.
To release the belt, press the buckle–release button.
—Seat belt extender
If your seat belt cannot be fastened securely because it is not long enough, a
personalized seat belt extender is available from your authorized Toyota CNG dealer
free of charge.
Please contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer so that he/she can order the
proper required length for the extender. Bring the heaviest coat you expect to wear
xliv
’99camry CNG
for proper measurement and selection of length. Additional ordering information is
available at your authorized Toyota CNG dealer.
CAUTION
When using the seat belt extender, observe the following. Failure to follow
these instructions could result in less effectiveness of the seat belt restraint
system in case of vehicle accident, increasing the chance of personal injury.
Never use the seat belt extender if you can fasten the seat belt without
it.
Remember that the extender provided for you may not be safe when used
on a different vehicle, or for another person or at a different seating
position than the one originally intended for.
xlv
’99camry CNG
To connect the extender to the seat belt, insert the tab into the seat belt
buckle so that the “PRESS” signs on the buckle–release buttons of the extender and the seat belt are both facing outward as shown.
You will hear a click when the tab locks into the buckle.
When releasing the seat belt, press on the buckle–release button on the extender,
not on the seat belt. This helps prevent damage to the vehicle interior and extender
itself.
When not in use, remove the extender and store in the vehicle for future use.
xlvi
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure the tab and buckle are locked and that
the seat belt extender is not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may prevent you from
properly latching the tab and buckle.
If the seat belt does not function normally, immediately contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer. Do not use the seat until the seat belt is fixed.
It cannot protect an adult occupant or your child from injury.
—Front seat belt pretensioners
The driver and front passenger’s seat belt pretensioners are designed to be
activated in response to a severe frontal impact.
xlvii
’99camry CNG
When the airbag sensor detects the shock of a severe frontal impact, the front seat
belt is quickly drawn back in by the retractor so that the belt snugly restrains the
front seat occupants.
The seat belt pretensioners are activated even with no passenger in the front seat.
This indicator comes on when the ignition key is turned to the “ACC” or “ON”
position. It goes off after about 6 seconds. This means the front seat belt
pretensioners are operating properly.
This warning light system monitors the airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensors, seat belt pretensioner assemblies, warning light, interconnecting wiring and
power sources. (For details, see “Service reminder indicators and warning buzzers”
in Chapter 1–5.)
xlviii
’99camry CNG
The seat belt pretensioner system mainly consists of the following components and
their locations are shown in the illustration.
1. Front airbag sensors
2. SRS warning light
3. Seat belt pretensioner assemblies
4. Airbag sensor assembly
The seat belt pretensioner is controlled by the airbag sensor assembly. The airbag
sensor assembly consists of a safing sensor and airbag sensor.
When a seat belt pretensioner is activated, an operating noise may be heard and
a small amount of smoke–like gas may be released. This gas is harmless and does
not indicate that a fire is occurring.
Once the seat belt pretensioner has been activated, the seat belt retractor remains
locked.
xlix
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not modify, remove, strike or open the front seat belt pretensioner
assemblies, airbag sensor or surrounding area or wiring. Doing any of these
may cause sudden operation of the front seat belt pretensioners or disable
the system, which could result in serious injury.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in serious injuries.
NOTICE
Do not perform any of the following changes without consulting your
authorized Toyota CNG dealer. Such changes can interfere with proper
operation of the seat belt pretensioners in some cases.
Installation of electronic items such as a mobile two–way radio, cassette
tape player or compact disc player
Repairs on or near the front seat belt retractor assemblies
Modification of the suspension system
Modification of the front end structure
Attachment of a grille guard (bull bar, kangaroo bar, etc.), snowplow,
winches or any other equipment to the front end
Repairs made on or near the front fenders, front end structure or console
l
’99camry CNG
This front seat belt pretensioner system has a service reminder indicator to inform
the driver of operating problems. If either of the following conditions occurs, this
indicates a malfunction of the airbags or pretensioners. Contact your authorized
Toyota CNG dealer as soon as possible to service the vehicle.
The light does not come on when the ignition key is turned to the “ACC” or “ON”
position, or remains on.
The light comes on or flashes while driving.
If either front seat belt does not retract or can not be pulled out due to a
malfunction or activation of the pretensioner.
The front seat belt pretensioner assembly or surrounding area has been damaged.
The front part of the vehicle (shaded in the illustration) was involved in an
accident that did not cause the seat belt pretensioners to operate.
The front seat belt pretensioner assembly is scratched, cracked, or otherwise
damaged.
li
’99camry CNG
SRS driver and front
passenger airbags
The SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) airbags are designed to provide
further protection for the driver and front passenger when added to the primary protection provided by the seat belts.
In response to a severe frontal impact, the SRS airbags work together with the seat
belts to help prevent or reduce injury by inflating, in order to decrease the likelihood
of the driver’s or front passenger’s head or chest directly hitting the steering wheel
or dashboard. The passenger airbag is activated even with no passenger in the front
seat.
Be sure to wear your seat belt.
lii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
A driver or front passenger too close to the steering wheel or dashboard
during airbag deployment can be killed or seriously injured. Toyota strongly
recommends that:
The driver sit as far back as possible from the steering wheel while still
maintaining control of the vehicle.
The front passenger sit as far back as possible from the dashboard.
All vehicle occupants be properly restrained using the available seat belts.
This indicator comes on when the ignition key is turned to the “ACC” or “ON”
position. It goes off after about 6 seconds. This means the SRS airbags are
operating properly.
liii
’99camry CNG
This warning light system monitors the airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensors, inflators, warning light, interconnecting wiring and power sources. (For details,
see “Service reminder indicators and warning buzzers” in Chapter 1–5.)
The SRS airbag system is designed to activate in response to a severe frontal
impact within the shaded area between the arrows in the illustration.
There may be the case that the SRS airbag will not activate with such an impact
in which the occupant wearing the seat belt correctly would not get serious injury.
The SRS airbags will deploy if the severity of the impact is above the designed
threshold level, comparable to an approximate 25 km/h (15 mph) collision when
impacting straight into a fixed barrier that does not move or deform.
If the severity of the impact is below the above threshold level, the SRS airbags
may not deploy.
liv
’99camry CNG
However, this threshold velocity will be considerably higher if the vehicle strikes an
object, such as a parked vehicle or sign pole, which can move or deform on impact,
or if it is involved in an underride collision (e.g. a collision in which the nose of
the vehicle “underrides”, or goes under, the bed of a truck, etc.).
It is possible with collision severity at the marginal level of airbag sensor detection
and activation that only one of your vehicle’s two airbags will deploy.
For the safety of all occupants, be sure to always wear seat belts.
Collision from the
rear
Collision from the side
Vehicle rollover
The SRS airbags are not designed to inflate if the vehicle is subjected to a
side or rear impact, if it rolls over, or if it is involved in a low–speed frontal
collision.
lv
’99camry CNG
Hitting a curb,
edge of pavement
or hard material
Falling into or
jumping over a
deep hole
Landing hard or vehicle falling
The SRS airbags may deploy if a serious impact occurs to the underside of
your vehicle. Some examples are shown in the illustration.
lvi
’99camry CNG
The SRS airbag system mainly consists of the following components and their
locations are shown in the illustration.
1. Front airbag sensors
2. SRS warning light
3. Airbag module for passenger (airbag and inflator)
4. Airbag sensor assembly
5. Airbag module for driver (airbag and inflator)
The airbag sensor assembly consists of a safing sensor and airbag sensor.
In a severe frontal impact, sensors detect deceleration and the system triggers the
airbag inflators. Then a chemical reaction in the inflators momentarily fills the
airbags with non–toxic gas to help restrain the forward motion of the occupants.
When the airbags inflate, they produce a fairly loud noise and release some smoke
and residue along with non–toxic gas. This does not indicate a fire. This gas is
normally harmless, however, for those who have delicate skin, it may cause minor
skin irritation. Be sure to wash off any residue as soon as possible to prevent minor
skin irritation.
Deployment of the airbags happens in a fraction of a second, so the airbags must
inflate with considerable force. While the system is designed to reduce serious
injuries, it may also cause minor burns or abrasions and swellings.
Parts of the airbag module (steering wheel hub, dashboard) may be hot for several
minutes, but the airbags themselves will not be hot. The airbags are designed to
inflate only once.
A crash severe enough to inflate the airbags may break the windshield as the
vehicle buckles. In vehicles with a passenger airbag the windshield may also be
damaged by absorbing some of the force of the inflating airbag.
lvii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
The SRS airbag system is designed only as a supplement to the primary
protection of the driver side and front passenger side seat belt systems.
The front seat occupants can be killed or seriously injured by an inflating
airbag if they do not wear the available seat belts. During sudden braking
just before a collision, an unrestrained driver or front passenger can move
forward into direct contact with or close proximity to the airbag which may
then deploy during the collision. To obtain maximum protection in an
accident, the driver and all passengers in the vehicle must wear their seat
belts. Wearing a seat belt during an accident reduces the chances of death
or serious injuries or being thrown out of the vehicle. For instructions and
precautions concerning the seat belt system, see “Seat belts” in this
chapter.
Improperly seated and/or restrained infants and children can be killed or
seriously injured by a deploying airbag. An infant or child who is too small
to use a seat belt should be properly secured using a child restraint
system. Toyota strongly recommends that all infants and children be
placed in the rear seat of the vehicle and properly restrained. The rear seat
is the safest for infants and children. For instructions concerning the
installation of a child restraint system, see “Child restraint” in this chapter.
lviii
’99camry CNG
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat because
the force of the rapid inflation of the passenger airbag can cause death
or serious injury to the child.
lix
’99camry CNG
Move seat
fully back
A forward–facing child restraint system should be allowed to put on the
front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as far back
as possible, because the force of a deploying airbag could cause death or
serious injury to the child.
For instructions concerning the installation of a child restraint system, see
“Child restraint” in this chapter.
lx
’99camry CNG
Do not sit on the edge of the seat or lean over the dashboard when the
vehicle is in use. The airbags inflate with considerable speed and force;
you may be killed or seriously injured. Sit up straight and well back in
the seat, and always use your seat belt.
lxi
’99camry CNG
Do not allow a child to stand up, or to kneel on the front passenger seat.
The airbag inflates with considerable speed and force; the child may be
killed or seriously injured.
Do not hold a child on your lap or in your arms. Use a child restraint
system in the rear seat. For instructions concerning the installation of a
child restraint system, see “Child restraint” in this chapter.
lxii
’99camry CNG
Do not put objects or your pets on or in front of the dashboard or
steering wheel pad that houses the airbag system. They might restrict
inflation or cause death or serious injury as they are projected rearward
by the force of deploying airbags. Likewise, the driver and front passenger
should not hold things in their arms or on their knees.
Do not modify or remove any wiring. Do not modify, remove, strike or
open any components such as the steering wheel pad, steering wheel,
column cover, front passenger airbag cover, front passenger airbag or
airbag sensor assembly. Doing any of these may cause sudden SRS airbag
inflation or disable the system, which could result in death or serious
injury.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injuries.
lxiii
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Do not perform any of the following changes without consulting your
authorized Toyota CNG dealer. Such changes can interfere with proper
operation of the SRS airbag system in some cases.
Installation of electronic items such as a mobile two–way radio, cassette
tape player or compact disc player
Modification of the suspension system
Modification of the front end structure
Attachment of a grille guard (bull bar, kangaroo bar, etc.), snowplow,
winches or any other equipment to the front end
Repairs made on or near the front fenders, front end structure, console,
steering column, steering wheel or dashboard near the front passenger
airbag
lxiv
’99camry CNG
This SRS airbag system has a service reminder indicator to inform the driver of
operating problems. If either of the following conditions occurs, this indicates a
malfunction of the airbags. Contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as
possible to service the vehicle.
The light does not come on when the ignition key is turned to the “ACC” or “ON”
position, or remains on.
The light comes on while driving.
lxv
’99camry CNG
Child restraint—
—Child restraint precautions
In the following cases, contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as
possible:
The SRS airbags have been inflated.
The front part of the vehicle (shaded in the illustration) was involved in an
accident that did not cause the SRS airbags to inflate.
The pad section of the steering wheel or front passenger airbag cover (shaded
in the illustration) is scratched, cracked, or otherwise damaged.
NOTICE
Do not disconnect the battery cables before contacting your authorized
Toyota CNG dealer.
lxvi
’99camry CNG
Toyota strongly urges the use of child restraint systems for children small
enough to use them.
The laws of all fifty states in the U.S.A. and Canada now require the use of a child
restraint system.
Your vehicle conforms to SAEJ1819.
If a child is too large for a child restraint system, the child should sit in the rear
seat and must be restrained using the vehicle’s seat belt. See “Seat belts” for
details.
CAUTION
For effective protection in automobile accidents and sudden stops, children
must be properly restrained using a seat belt or child restraint system
depending on the age and size of the child. Holding a child in your arms
is not a substitute for a child restraint system. In an accident, the child
can be crushed against the windshield, or between you and the vehicle’s
interior.
lxvii
’99camry CNG
Toyota strongly urges use of a proper child restraint system which conforms to the size of the child, and is put on the rear seat. According to
accident statistics, the child is safer when properly restrained in the rear
seat than in the front seat.
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat. In the
event of an accident, the force of the rapid inflation of the airbag can
cause death or serious injury if a rear–facing child restraint system is put
on the front seat.
Unless it is unavoidable, do not put a child restraint system on the front
seat.
A forward–facing child restraint system should be allowed to put on the
front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as far back
as possible, because the force of a deploying airbag could cause death or
serious injury to the child.
Make sure that you have complied with all installation instructions provided by the child restraint manufacturer and that the system is properly
secured.
—Child restraint system
A child restraint system for a small child or baby must itself be properly
restrained on the seat with either the lap belt or the lap portion of the
lap/shoulder belt. You must carefully consult the manufacturer’s instructions
which accompany your child restraint system.
To provide proper restraint, use a child restraint system following the manufacturer’s
instructions about the appropriate age and size of the child for the restraint system.
lxviii
’99camry CNG
Install the child restraint system correctly following the instructions provided by its
manufacturer of the system. General directions are also provided under the following
illustrations.
The child restraint system should be installed on the rear seat. According to
accident statistics, the child is safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than
in the front seat.
CAUTION
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat. In the
event of an accident, the force of the rapid inflation of the airbag can
cause death or serious injury if a rear–facing child restraint system is put
on the front seat.
Unless it is unavoidable, do not put a child restraint system on the front
seat.
A forward–facing child restraint system should be allowed to put on the
front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as far back
as possible, because the force of a deploying airbag could cause death or
serious injury to the child.
After installing the child restraint system, make sure it is secured in place
following the manufacturer’s instructions. If it is not restrained securely,
it may cause death or serious injury to the child in the event of a sudden
stop or accident.
When not using the child restraint system, keep it secured with the seat belt or
place it in the trunk or somewhere other than the passenger compartment. This will
prevent it from injuring passengers in the event of a sudden stop or accident.
lxix
’99camry CNG
—Types of child restraint
system
Child restraint systems are classified into the following 3 types depending on the
child’s age and size.
(A) Infant seat
(B) Convertible seat
(C) Booster seat
Install the child restraint system following the instructions provided by its manufacturer.
(A) Infant seat
lxx
’99camry CNG
(B) Convertible seat
(C) Booster seat
lxxi
’99camry CNG
—Installation with 2–point
type seat belt
(A) INFANT SEAT INSTALLATION
An infant seat is used in rear–facing position only.
lxxii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not put a rear–facing child restraint system on the rear seat if it interferes with the lock mechanism of the front seats. This can cause severe
injury to the child and front passenger in case of sudden braking or a
collision.
lxxiii
’99camry CNG
1. Run the center lap belt through or around the infant seat following the instructions provided by its manufacturer and insert the tab into the buckle taking care
not to twist the lap belt.
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure the tab and buckle are locked and that
the lap belt is not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may prevent you from
properly latching the tab and buckle.
If the seat belt does not function normally, it cannot protect your child
from injury. Contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer immediately. Do
not use the seat until the seat belt is fixed.
lxxiv
’99camry CNG
2. While pressing the infant seat firmly against the seat cushion and seatback,
tighten the lap belt by pulling its free end to hold the infant seat securely.
lxxv
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Push and pull the child restraint system in different directions to be sure
it is secure. Follow all the installation instructions provided by its manufacturer.
3. To remove the infant seat, press the buckle–release button.
lxxvi
’99camry CNG
(B) CONVERTIBLE SEAT INSTALLATION
A convertible seat is used in forward–facing and rear–facing position depending on the child’s age and size. When installing, follow the manufacturer’s
instructions about the applicable child’s age and size as well as directions for
installing a child restraint system.
lxxvii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not put a rear–facing child restraint system on the rear seat if it interferes with the lock mechanism of the front seats. This can cause severe
injury to the child and front passenger in case of sudden braking or a
collision.
lxxviii
’99camry CNG
1. Run the center lap belt through or around the convertible seat following the
instructions provided by its manufacturer and insert the tab into the buckle taking
care not to twist the lap belt.
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure the tab and buckle are locked and that
the lap belt is not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may prevent you from
properly latching the tab and buckle.
If the seat belt does not function normally, it cannot protect your child
from injury. Contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer immediately. Do
not use the seat until the seat belt is fixed.
lxxix
’99camry CNG
2. While pressing the convertible seat firmly against the seat cushion and seatback,
tighten the lap belt by pulling its free end to hold the convertible seat securely.
lxxx
’99camry CNG
—Installation with 3–point
type seat belt
CAUTION
Push and pull the child restraint system in different directions to be sure
it is secure. Follow all the installation instructions provided by its manufacturer.
3. To remove the convertible seat, press the buckle–release button.
lxxxi
’99camry CNG
(A) INFANT SEAT INSTALLATION
An infant seat is used in rear–facing position only.
lxxxii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat because
the force of the rapid inflation of the passenger airbag can cause death
or serious injury to the child.
Do not put a rear–facing child restraint system on the rear seat if it
interferes with the lock mechanism of the front seats. This can cause
severe injury to the child and front passenger in case of sudden braking
or a collision.
lxxxiii
’99camry CNG
1. Run the lap and shoulder belt through or around the infant seat following the
instructions provided by its manufacturer and insert the tab into the buckle taking
care not to twist the belt. Keep the lap portion of the belt tight.
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure the tab and buckle are locked and that
the lap and shoulder portions of the belt are not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may prevent you from
properly latching the tab and buckle.
If the seat belt does not function normally, it cannot protect your child
from injury. Contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer immediately. Do
not use the seat until the seat belt is fixed.
lxxxiv
’99camry CNG
2. Fully extend the shoulder belt to put it in the lock mode. When the belt is then
retracted even slightly, it cannot be extended.
To hold the infant seat securely, make sure the belt is in the lock mode before
letting the belt retract.
lxxxv
’99camry CNG
3. While pressing the infant seat firmly against the seat cushion and seatback, let
the shoulder belt retract as far as it will go to hold the infant seat securely.
lxxxvi
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Push and pull the child restraint system in different directions to be sure
it is secure. Follow all the installation instructions provided by its manufacturer.
4. To remove the infant seat, press the buckle–release button and allow the belt
to retract completely. The belt will move freely again and be ready to work for
an adult or older child passenger.
lxxxvii
’99camry CNG
(B) CONVERTIBLE SEAT INSTALLATION
A convertible seat is used in forward–facing and rear–facing position depending on the child’s age and size. When installing, follow the manufacturer’s
instructions about the applicable child’s age and size as well as directions for
installing a child restraint system.
lxxxviii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Never put a rear–facing child restraint system on the front seat because
the force of the rapid inflation of the passenger airbag can cause death
or serious injury to the child.
lxxxix
’99camry CNG
Move seat
fully back
A forward–facing child restraint system should be allowed to put on the
front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as far back
as possible, because the force of a deploying airbag could cause death or
serious injury to the child.
xc
’99camry CNG
Do not put a rear–facing child restraint system on the rear seat if it
interferes with the lock mechanism of the front seats. This can cause
severe injury to the child and front passenger in case of sudden braking
or a collision.
xci
’99camry CNG
1. Run the lap and shoulder belt through or around the convertible seat following
the instructions provided by its manufacturer and insert the tab into the buckle
taking care not to twist the belt. Keep the lap portion of the belt tight.
CAUTION
After inserting the tab, make sure the tab and buckle are locked and that
the lap and shoulder portions of the belt are not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may prevent you from
properly latching the tab and buckle.
If the seat belt does not function normally, it cannot protect your child
from injury. Contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer immediately. Do
not use the seat until the seat belt is fixed.
xcii
’99camry CNG
2. Fully extend the shoulder belt to put it in the lock mode. When the belt is then
retracted even slightly, it cannot be extended.
To hold the convertible seat securely, make sure the belt is in the lock mode before
letting the belt retract.
xciii
’99camry CNG
3. While pressing the convertible seat firmly against the seat cushion and seatback,
let the shoulder belt retract as far as it will go to hold the convertible seat
securely.
xciv
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Push and pull the child restraint system in different directions to be sure
it is secure. Follow all the installation instructions provided by its manufacturer.
4. To remove the convertible seat, press the buckle–release button and allow the
belt to retract completely. The belt will move freely again and be ready to work
for an adult or older child passenger.
xcv
’99camry CNG
(C) BOOSTER SEAT INSTALLATION
A booster seat is used in forward–facing position only.
Move seat fully back
xcvi
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
A forward–facing child restraint system should be allowed to put on the
front seat only when it is unavoidable. Always move the seat as far back
as possible, because the force of a deploying airbag could cause death or
serious injury to the child.
1. Sit the child on a booster seat. Run the lap and shoulder belt through or around
the booster seat and child following the instructions provided by its manufacturer
and insert the tab into the buckle taking care not to twist the belt.
Make sure the shoulder belt is correctly across the child’s shoulder and that the
lap belt is positioned as low as possible on child’s hips. See “Seat belts” for details.
xcvii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Always make sure the shoulder belt is positioned across the center of
child’s shoulder. The belt should be kept away from child’s neck, but not
falling off child’s shoulder. Failure to do so could reduce the amount of
protection in an accident and cause serious injuries in a collision.
High–positioned lap belts and loose–fitting belts both could cause serious
injuries due to sliding under the lap belt during a collision or other
unintended result. Keep the lap belt positioned as low on hips as possible.
For child’s safety, do not place the shoulder belt under child’s arm.
After inserting the tab, make sure the tab and buckle are locked and that
the lap and shoulder portions of the belt are not twisted.
Do not insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may prevent you from
properly latching the tab and buckle.
If the seat belt does not function normally, it cannot protect your child
from injury. Contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer immediately. Do
not use the seat until the seat belt is fixed.
xcviii
’99camry CNG
2. To remove the child restraint system, press the buckle–release button and allow
the belt to retract.
Tilt steering wheel
xcix
’99camry CNG
To change the steering wheel angle, hold the steering wheel, pull up the lock
release lever, tilt the steering wheel to the desired angle and release the lever.
When the steering wheel is in a low position, it will spring up as you release the
lock release lever.
CAUTION
Do not adjust the steering wheel while the vehicle is moving.
After adjusting the steering wheel, try moving it up and down to make sure
it is locked in position.
Outside rear view mirrors—
Adjust the mirror so that you can just see the side of your vehicle in the
mirror.
c
’99camry CNG
—Power rear view mirror
Be
careful when judging the size or distance of any object seen in the outside rear
control
view mirror on the passenger’s side. It is a convex mirror with a curved surface.
Any object seen in a convex mirror will look smaller and farther away than when
seen in a flat mirror.
On some models, when you push the rear window defogger switch, the heater
panels in the outside rear view mirrors will quickly clear the mirror surface.
CAUTION
Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is moving. It may cause the
driver to mishandle the vehicle and an accident may occur resulting in
personal injuries.
Since the mirror surfaces can get hot, keep your hands off them when the
defogger switch is on.
ci
’99camry CNG
Anti–glare inside rear view
mirror
To adjust a mirror, use the switches.
1. Master switch—To select the mirror to be adjusted
Place the switch at “L” (left) or “R” (right).
2. Control switch—To move the mirror Push the switch in the desired direction.
Mirror can be adjusted when key is in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
NOTICE
If ice should jam the mirror, do not operate the control or scrape the mirror
face. Use a spray de–icer to free the mirror.
cii
’99camry CNG
Adjust the mirror so that you can just see the rear of your vehicle in the
mirror.
To reduce glare from the headlights of the vehicle behind you during night
driving, operate the lever on the lower edge of the mirror.
Daylight driving—Lever at position 1
The reflection in the mirror has greater clarity at this position.
Night driving—Lever at position 2
Remember that by reducing glare you also lose some rear view clarity.
CAUTION
Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is moving. It may cause the driver
to mishandle the vehicle and an accident may occur resulting in personal
injuries.
ciii
’99camry CNG
Sun visors—
To block out glare, move the sun visor.
To block out glare from the front—Swing down the sun visor (position 1).
To block out glare from the side—Swing down the sun visor, remove it from the
hook and swing it to the lateral side (position 2).
If glare comes from obliquely behind you, extend the plate at the end of the visor
(to position 3 or 4).
CAUTION
Do not extend the plate at the end of the sun visor when the visor is in
the position 1. It can cover the anti–glare inside rear view mirror and
obstruct the rear view.
civ
’99camry CNG
—Vanity mirrors
To use the vanity mirrors, swing down the sun visor and open the cover.
cv
’99camry CNG
cvi
’99camry CNG
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–4
Lights, Wipers and
Defogger
Headlights and turn signals
Emergency flashers
Instrument panel light control
Interior light
Ignition switch light
Windshield wipers and washer
Rear window and outside
rear view mirror defoggers
Headlights and turn signals
cvii
’99camry CNG
HEADLIGHTS
To turn on the following lights: Twist the headlight/turn signal lever knob.
Position 1—Parking, tail, license plate, side marker and instrument panel lights
Position 2—Headlights and all of the above
The lights automatically turn off when the driver’s door is opened with the ignition
turned off. To turn them on again, turn the key to the “ON” position or actuate the
headlight switch. If you are going to park for over one week, make sure the
headlight switch is off.
NOTICE
To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not leave the lights on for
a long period when the engine is not running.
cviii
’99camry CNG
High–Low beams—For high beams, turn the headlights on and push the lever away
from you (position 1). Pull the lever toward you (position 2) for low beams.
The headlight high beam indicator light (blue light) on the instrument panel will tell
you that the high beams are on.
Flashing the high beam headlights (position 3)—Pull the lever all the way back.
The high beam headlights turn off when you release the lever.
You can flash the high beam headlights with the knob turned to “OFF”.
cix
’99camry CNG
TURN SIGNALS
To signal a turn, push the headlight/turn signal lever up or down to position
1.
The key must be in the “ON” position.
The lever automatically returns after you make a turn, but you may have to return
it by hand after you change lanes.
To signal a lane change, move the lever up or down to the pressure point (position
2) and hold it.
If the turn signal indicator lights (green lights) on the instrument panel flash faster
than normal, a front or rear turn signal bulb is burned out.
Emergency flashers
cx
’99camry CNG
To turn on the emergency flashers, push the switch.
All the turn signal lights will flash. To turn them off, push the switch once again.
Turn on the emergency flashers to warn other drivers if your vehicle must be
stopped where it might be a traffic hazard.
Always pull as far off the road as possible.
The turn signal light switch will not work when the emergency flashers are operating.
NOTICE
To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not leave the switch on
longer than necessary when the engine is not running.
Instrument panel light control
cxi
’99camry CNG
To adjust the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the knob.
Interior light
To turn on the interior light, slide the switch.
cxii
’99camry CNG
Windshield wipers and
The
interior light switch has the following positions:
washer
“ON”—Keeps the light on all the time.
“OFF”—Turns the light off.
“DOOR”—Turns the light on when any of the door is opened. The light goes off
when all the doors are closed.
Ignition switch light
For easy access to the ignition switch, the ignition switch light comes on
when any of the doors are opened.
The light remains on for a certain time after all the doors are closed.
When all the doors are locked or the ignition switch is turned to “ACC”, “ON” after
all the doors are closed, the light fades out.
cxiii
’99camry CNG
To turn on the windshield wipers, move the lever to the desired setting.
The key must be in the “ON” position.
Lever position
Speed setting
Position 1
Intermittent
Position 2
Slow
Position 3
Fast
With interval adjuster: The “INT TIME” band lets you adjust the wiping time interval
when the wiper lever is in the intermittent position (position 1). Twist the band
upward to increase the time between sweeps, and downward to decrease it.
To squirt washer fluid, pull the lever toward you.
If the windshield wipers are off, they will operate a couple of times after the washer
squirts.
cxiv
’99camry CNG
Rear window and outside
For
instructions
on adding
washer fluid, see “Adding washer fluid” in Chapter 7–3.
rear
view mirror
defoggers
In freezing weather, warm the windshield with the defroster before using the washer.
This will help prevent the washer fluid from freezing on your windshield, which can
block your vision.
NOTICE
Do not operate the wipers if the windshield is dry. It may scratch the glass.
To defog or defrost the rear window, push the switch.
The key must be in the “ON” position.
The thin heater wires on the inside of the rear window will quickly clear the
surfaces. An indicator light will illuminate to indicate the defogger is operating.
On some models, heater panels in the outside rear view mirrors will also quickly
clear the surfaces.
cxv
’99camry CNG
Push the switch once again to turn the defogger off.
The system will automatically shut off after the defogger has operated about 15
minutes.
CAUTION
Since the mirror surfaces can get hot keep your hands off them when the
defogger switch is on.
Make sure you turn the defoggers off when the surfaces are clear. Leaving the
defoggers on for a long time could cause the battery to discharge, especially during
stop–and–go driving. The defoggers are not designed for drying rain water or for
melting snow.
If the outside rear view mirrors are heavily coated with ice, use a spray de–icer
before operating the switch.
NOTICE
When cleaning the inside of the rear window, be careful not to scratch or
damage the heater wires.
cxvi
’99camry CNG
cxvii
’99camry CNG
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–5
Gauges, Meters and
Service reminder
indicators
Fuel gauge
Engine coolant temperature
gauge
Tachometer
Odometer and two trip meters
Service reminder indicators and
warning buzzers
Fuel gauge
cxviii
’99camry CNG
Low fuel level
warning light
The gauge works when the ignition switch is on and indicates the approximate
quantity of fuel remaining in the tank.
Nearly full—Needle at “F”
Nearly empty—Needle at around 1/5 position
It is a good idea to keep the tank over 1/4 full.
This fuel gauge has a non–return type needle which remains at the last indicated
position when the ignition switch is turned off.
This gauge indicates the amount of fuel remaining in the tank is calculated from
the pressure of the natural gas and the temperature inside the tank. The actual
amount may be slightly above or below that indicated, depending on the outside
temperature and environment.
If the low fuel level warning light comes on, fill the fuel tank as soon as possible.
If you continue to drive the vehicle after the low fuel level warning light comes on,
the light will begin to blink, and at the same time you will not be able to drive
at speeds over 80 km/h (50 mph).
cxix
’99camry CNG
Engine coolant temperature
gauge
NOTICE
If the low fuel warning light begins to blink, the fuel tank will soon be
empty. Move to a safe place as soon as possible.
The gauge indicates the engine coolant temperature when the ignition switch
is on. The engine operating temperature will vary with changes in weather and
engine load.
If the needle moves into the red zone, your engine is too hot. If your vehicle
overheats, stop your vehicle and allow the engine to cool.
Your vehicle may overheat during severe operating conditions, such as:
Driving up a long hill on a hot day.
Reducing speed or stopping after high speed driving.
cxx
’99camry CNG
Idling for a long period with the air conditioning on in stop–and–go traffic.
Towing a trailer.
NOTICE
Do not remove the thermostat in the engine cooling system as this may
cause the engine to overheat. The thermostat is designed to control the
flow of coolant to keep the temperature of the engine within the specified
operating range.
Do not continue driving with an overheated engine. See “If your vehicle
overheats” in Part 4.
Tachometer
The tachometer indicates engine speed in thousands of rpm (revolutions per
minute). Use it while driving to select correct shift points and to prevent
engine lugging and overrevving.
cxxi
’99camry CNG
Driving with the engine running too fast causes excessive engine wear and poor
fuel economy. Remember, in most cases the slower the engine speed, the greater
the fuel economy.
NOTICE
Do not let the indicator needle get into the red zone. This may cause severe
engine damage.
Odometer and two trip meters
This meter displays the odometer and two trip meters.
1. Odometer—It shows the total distance the vehicle has been driven.
2. Two trip meters—They show two different distances independently driven since
the last time each trip meter was set to zero.
You can use one trip meter to calculate the fuel economy and the other to
measure the distance on each trip. All trip meter data is cancelled if the
electrical power source is disconnected.
cxxii
’99camry CNG
Service reminder indicators
and warning buzzers
3. Trip meter reset knob—It can reset the two trip meters to zero, and also change
the meter display.
To change the meter display, quickly push and release the knob. The meter
display changes in the order from the odometer to trip meter A to trip meter
B, then back to the odometer each time you push.
To reset the trip meter A to zero, display the meter A reading, then push and
hold the knob until the meter is set to zero. The same process can be applied
for resetting the trip meter B.
cxxiii
’99camry CNG
If the indicator or buzzer
below comes on...
Do this .
( a)
If parking brake
is off, stop and
check.
(b)
Fasten seat belt.
(Indicator and buzzer)
(c)
Stop and check.
(d)
Take vehicle to
authorized Toyota
CNG dealer.
(e)
(f)
Low fuel level
warning light
Fill the tank up.
Stop and check .
cxxiv
’99camry CNG
If the indicator or buzzer
below comes on...
Do this.
(g)
Take vehicle to
authorized Toyota
CNG dealer.
(h)
Close all doors.
(i)
Replace bulb.
(j)
Take vehicle to
authorized Toyota
CNG dealer
immediately.
(k)
Add washer fluid.
(l)
Key reminder
buzzer
Remove key.
(a) Brake System Warning Light
cxxv
’99camry CNG
This light has the following functions:
Parking brake reminder
If this light is on, make sure the parking brake is fully released. The light should
go off.
Low brake fluid level warning
If this light comes on and stays on while you are driving, slow down and pull off
the road. Then stop the vehicle carefully. Remember that stopping distance and
pedal effort may be increased. There may be a problem somewhere in the brake
system. Check the fluid level of the see–through reservoir.
To make sure the parking brake has not caused the warning light to come on,
check to see that the parking brake is fully released.
If the brake fluid level is low...
At a safe place, test your brakes by starting and stopping.
If you judge that the brakes still work adequately, drive cautiously to the nearest
authorized Toyota CNG dealer or shop for repairs.
If the brakes are not working, have the vehicle towed in for repairs. (For towing
information, see Part 4.)
CAUTION
It is dangerous to continue driving normally when the brake fluid level is
low.
If the brake fluid level is correct...
Have the warning system checked by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer.
(b) Seat Belt Reminder Light and Buzzer
cxxvi
’99camry CNG
This light and buzzer remind you to buckle up the driver’s seat belt.
Once the ignition key is turned to “ON” or “START”, the reminder light and buzzer
come on if the driver’s seat belt is not fastened. Unless the driver fastens the belt,
the light stays on and the buzzer stops after about 4 to 8 seconds.
(c) Discharge Warning Light
This light warns that the battery is being discharged.
If it comes on while you are driving, there is a problem somewhere in the charging
system.
The engine ignition will continue to operate, however, until the battery is discharged.
Turn off the air conditioning, blower, radio, etc., and drive directly to the nearest
authorized Toyota CNG dealer or repair shop.
NOTICE
Do not continue driving if the engine drive belt is broken or loose.
(d) Malfunction Indicator Lamp
This lamp warns that there is a problem somewhere in your engine or automatic
transmission electrical system.
If it comes on while you are driving, have your vehicle checked/repaired by your
authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as possible.
(e) Low Fuel Level Warning Light
This light comes on when the amount of natural gas remaining in the tank drops
to about 1/5.
If you continue to drive the vehicle after the low fuel level warning light comes on,
the light will begin to blink, and at the same time you will not be able to drive
at speeds over 80 km/h (50 mph).
cxxvii
’99camry CNG
When the outside temperature is below –30°C (–22°F), the fuel gauge may indicate
an amount less than actual amount and the indicator may come on.
NOTICE
If the low fuel warning light begins to blink, the fuel tank will soon be
empty. Move to a safe place as soon as possible.
(f) Low Oil Pressure Warning Light
This light warns that the engine oil pressure is too low.
If it flickers or stays on while you are driving, pull off the road to a safe place
and stop the engine immediately. Call your authorized Toyota CNG dealer or qualified repair shop for assistance.
The light may occasionally flicker when the engine is idling or it may come on
briefly after a hard stop. There is no cause for concern if it then goes out when
the engine is accelerated slightly.
The light may come on when the oil level is extremely low. It is not designed to
indicate low oil level, and the oil level must be checked using the level dipstick.
NOTICE
Do not drive the vehicle with the warning light on—even for one block. It
may ruin the engine.
(g) “ABS” Warning Light
This light warns that there is a problem somewhere in your anti–lock brake system.
cxxviii
’99camry CNG
If the light comes on while you are driving, have your vehicle checked by your
authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as possible.
The light will come on when the ignition key is turned to the “ON” position. After
a few seconds, the light will go off.
When the “ABS” warning light is on (and the brake system warning light is off),
the brake system operates conventionally but anti–lock brake system is not assisting
brake performance so that the wheels can lock–up during sudden braking or braking
on slippery road surfaces.
(h) Open Door Warning Light
This light remains on until all the doors and back door are completely closed.
(i) Rear Light Failure Warning Light
If this light comes on when the headlight switch is turned on (at the first or second
clickstop), it indicates that one or more of the tail lights are burned out.
If it comes on when the brake pedal is depressed, one or more stop lights are
burned out.
Have defective bulbs replaced as soon as possible.
(j) SRS Warning Light
This light will come on when the ignition key is turned to the “ACC” or “ON”
position. After about 6 seconds, the light will go off. This means the systems
of the airbag and front seat belt pretensioner are operating properly.
The warning light system monitors the airbag sensor assembly, front airbag sensors,
seat belt pretensioner assemblies, inflators, warning light, interconnecting wiring and
power sources.
If either of the following conditions occurs, this indicates a malfunction somewhere
in the parts monitored by the warning light system. Contact your authorized Toyota
CNG dealer as soon as possible to service the vehicle.
cxxix
’99camry CNG
The light does not come on when the ignition key is turned to the “ACC” or “ON”
position or remains on.
The light comes on or flashes while driving.
(k) Low Windshield Washer Fluid Level Warning Light
The light warns that the windshield washer fluid level is too low. Add washer fluid
at your earliest opportunity. (For instructions, see “Adding washer fluid” in Chapter
7–3.)
(l) Key Reminder Buzzer
This buzzer reminds you to remove the key when you open the driver’s door with
the ignition key in the “ACC” or “LOCK” position.
CHECKING SERVICE REMINDER INDICATORS (except the low fuel level warning
light and low windshield washer fluid level warning light)
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. Open one of the doors.
The open door warning light should come on.
3. Close the door.
The open door warning light should go off.
4. Turn the ignition key to “ACC”.
The SRS warning light should come on. It goes off after about 6 seconds.
5. Turn the ignition key to “ON”, but do not start the engine.
All the service reminder indicators except the open door warning light, SRS
warning light and low windshield washer fluid level warning light should come on.
The “ABS” warning light goes off after a few seconds.
cxxx
’99camry CNG
If any service reminder indicator or warning buzzer does not function as described
above, either the bulb is burned out or the circuit is in need of repair. Have it
checked by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as possible.
cxxxi
’99camry CNG
Ignition switch with steering
lock 1
Part
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–6
Ignition switch,
Transmission and
Parking brake
Ignition switch with steering lock
Automatic transmission
Parking brake
Cruise control
cxxxii
’99camry CNG
“START”—Starter motor on. The key will return to the “ON” position when
released.
For starting tips, see Part 3.
“ON”—Engine on and all accessories on.
This is the normal driving position.
“ACC”—Accessories such as the radio operate, but the engine is off.
If you leave the key in the “ACC” or “LOCK” position and open the driver’s door,
a buzzer will remind you to remove the key.
“LOCK”—Engine is off and the steering wheel is locked. The key can be
removed only at this position.
You must push in the key to turn the key from “ACC” to the “LOCK” position. The
selector lever must be put in the “P” position before pushing the key.
cxxxiii
’99camry CNG
When starting the engine, the key may seem stuck at the “LOCK” position. To free
it, first be sure the key is pushed all the way in, and then rock the steering wheel
slightly while turning the key gently.
NOTICE
Do not leave the key in the “ON” position if the engine is not running. The
battery will discharge and the ignition could be damaged.
cxxxiv
’99camry CNG
Automatic transmission
Lock release button
To prevent misshifting
Parking, engine
starting and key
removal position
Reverse position
Overdrive switch
For selecting either a three–speed
or four–speed transmission
ON position
(Shifting into overdrive
possible)
Neutral position
Normal driving position
Position for engine
braking
Position for stronger
engine braking than
that in “2” position
With the brake pedal depressed,
shift while holding the lock
release button in. (The ignition
switch must be in “ON” position.)
Shift while holding the lock
release button in
OFF position
(Shifting into overdrive
not possible)
“O/D OFF” indicator light
shows the overdrive
switch is in OFF position
Shift normally
Vehicles with cruise controlWhen the cruise control is being used, even if you
downshift the transmission by turning off the overdrive switch, engine braking will
cxxxv
’99camry CNG
not be applied because the cruise control is not cancelled. For ways to decrease
the vehicle speed, see “Cruise control” in this chapter.
Your automatic transmission has a shift lock system to minimize the possibility of
incorrect operation. This means you can only shift out of “P” position when the
brake pedal is depressed (with the ignition switch in “ON” position and the lock
release button depressed).
(a) Normal driving
1. Start the engine as instructed in “How to start the engine” in Part 3. The
transmission must be in “P” or “N”.
2. With your foot holding down the brake pedal, shift the selector lever to “D”.
When the lever is in the “D” position, the automatic transmission system will select
the most suitable gear for the running conditions such as normal cruising, hill
climbing, hard towing, etc.
Always turn the overdrive switch on for better fuel economy and quieter driving. If
the engine coolant temperature is low, the transmission will not shift into overdrive
gear even with the overdrive switch on.
CAUTION
Never put your foot on the accelerator pedal while shifting.
3. Release the parking brake and brake pedal. Depress the accelerator pedal slowly
for smooth starting.
(b) Using engine braking
To use engine braking, you can downshift the transmission as follows:
cxxxvi
’99camry CNG
Turn off the overdrive switch. The “O/D OFF” indicator light will come on and
the transmission will downshift to the third gear.
Shift into the “2” position. The transmission will downshift to the second gear
when the vehicle speed drops down to or lower than 106 km/h (66 mph), and
more powerful engine braking will be obtained.
Shift into the “L” position. The transmission will downshift to the first gear When
the vehicle speed drops down to or lower than 47 km/h (29 mph), and maximum
engine braking will be applied.
Vehicles with cruise controlWhen the cruise control is being used, even if you
downshift the transmission by turning off the overdrive switch, engine braking is not
applied because the cruise control is not cancelled.
For ways to decrease the vehicle speed, see “Cruise control” in this chapter.
CAUTION
Be careful when downshifting on a slippery surface. Abrupt shifting could
cause the vehicle to spin or skid.
(c) Using “2” and “L” positions
The “2” and “L” positions are used for strong engine braking as described previously.
With the selector lever in “2” or “L”, you can start the vehicle in motion as with
the lever in “D”.
With the selector lever in “2”, the vehicle will start in the first gear and automatically shift to the second gear.
With the selector lever in “L”, the transmission is engaged in the first gear.
cxxxvii
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Be careful not to overrev the engine. Watch the tachometer to keep engine
rpm from going into the red zone. The approximate maximum allowable
speed for each position is given below for your reference:
“2” . . . . . . . . . . 119 km/h (74 mph)
“L” . . . . . . . . . . 66 km/h (41 mph)
Do not continue hill climbing or hard towing for a long time in the “2”
or “L” position. This may cause severe automatic transmission damage
from overheating. To prevent such damage, “D” position should be used
in hill climbing or hard towing.
(d) Backing up
1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.
2. With the brake pedal held down with your foot, shift the selector lever to the
“R” position.
NOTICE
Never shift into reverse while the vehicle is moving.
(e) Parking
1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.
2. Pull the parking brake lever up fully to securely apply the parking brake.
3. With the brake pedal pressed down, shift the selector lever to the “P” position.
cxxxviii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
While the vehicle is moving, never attempt to move the selector lever into
“P” position under any circumstances. Serious mechanical damage and loss
of vehicle control may result.
(f) Good driving practice
If the transmission repeatedly shifts up and down between the third gear and
overdrive when climbing a gentle slope, the overdrive switch should be turned
off. Be sure to turn the switch on immediately afterward.
When towing a trailer, in order to maintain engine braking efficiency, do not use
overdrive.
CAUTION
Always keep your foot on the brake pedal while stopped with the engine
running. This prevents the vehicle from creeping.
NOTICE
Do not hold the vehicle on an upgrade with the accelerator pedal. It can
cause the transmission to overheat. Always use the brake pedal or parking
brake.
(g) Rocking your vehicle if stuck
cxxxix
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
If your vehicle becomes stuck in snow, mud, sand, etc., then you may
attempt to rock your vehicle free by moving it forward and backward. Do not
attempt this procedure if people or objects are anywhere near the vehicle.
During the rocking operation the vehicle may suddenly move forward or
backward as it becomes unstuck, causing injury or damage to nearby people
or objects.
NOTICE
If you rock your vehicle, observe the following precautions to prevent damage to the transmission and other parts.
Do not depress the accelerator pedal while shifting the selector lever or
before the transmission is completely shifted to forward or reverse gear.
Do not race the engine and avoid spinning the wheels.
If your vehicle remains stuck after rocking the vehicle several times, consider other ways such as towing.
(h) If you cannot shift the selector lever out of “P” position
If you cannot shift the selector lever from “P” position even though the brake pedal
is depressed, use the shift lock override button. For instructions, see “If you cannot
shift automatic transmission selector lever” in Part 4.
Parking brake
cxl
’99camry CNG
When parking, firmly apply the parking brake to avoid inadvertent creeping.
To set: Pull up the lever. For better holding power, first depress the brake pedal
and hold it while setting the parking brake.
To release: Pull up the lever slightly, press the thumb button, and lower.
To remind you that the parking brake is set, the parking brake reminder light in
the instrument panel remains on until you release the parking brake.
CAUTION
Before driving, be sure the parking brake is fully released and the parking
brake reminder light is off.
Cruise control
The cruise control allows you to cruise the vehicle at a desired speed over
40 km/h (25 mph) even with your foot off the accelerator pedal.
cxli
’99camry CNG
Your cruising speed can be maintained up or down grades within the limits of
engine performance, although a slight speed change may occur when driving up or
down the grades. On steeper hills, a greater speed change will occur so it is better
to drive without the cruise control.
CAUTION
To help maintain maximum control of your vehicle, do not use the cruise
control when driving in heavy or varying traffic, or on slippery (rainy, icy
or snow–covered) or winding roads.
Avoid vehicle speed increases when driving downhill. If the vehicle speed
is too fast in relation to the cruise control set speed, cancel the cruise
control then downshift the transmission to use engine braking to slow
down.
TURNING ON THE SYSTEM
cxlii
’99camry CNG
To operate the cruise control, press the “CRUISE ON·OFF” button. This turns the
system on. The indicator light in the instrument panel shows that you can now set
the vehicle at a desired cruising speed. Another press will turn the system completely off.
CAUTION
To avoid accidental cruise control engagement, keep the “CRUISE ON·OFF”
switch off when not using the cruise control.
SETTING AT A DESIRED SPEED
The transmission must be in “D” before you set the cruise control speed.
Bring your vehicle to the desired speed, push the lever down in the “SET/COAST”
direction and release it. This sets the vehicle at that speed. If the speed is not
satisfactory, tap the lever up for a faster speed, or tap it down for a slower speed.
cxliii
’99camry CNG
Each tap changes the set speed by 1.6 km/h (1.0 mph). You can now take your
foot off the accelerator pedal.
If you need acceleration—for example, when passing—depress the accelerator pedal
enough for the vehicle to exceed the set speed. When you release it, the vehicle
will return to the speed set prior to the acceleration.
CANCELLING THE PRESET SPEED
You can cancel the preset speed by:
a. Pulling the lever in the “CANCEL” direction and releasing it.
b.
Depressing the brake pedal.
If the vehicle speed falls below about 40 km/h (25 mph), the preset speed will
automatically cancel out.
If the vehicle speed drops 16 km/h (10 mph) below the preset speed, the preset
speed will also automatically cancel out.
If the preset speed automatically cancels out other than for the above cases, have
your vehicle checked by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer at the earliest opportunity.
RESETTING TO A FASTER SPEED
Push the lever up in the “RES/ACC” direction and hold it. Release the lever when
the desired speed is attained. While the lever is held up, the vehicle will gradually
gain speed.
However, a faster way to reset is to accelerate the vehicle and then push the lever
down in the “SET/COAST” direction.
RESETTING TO A SLOWER SPEED
cxliv
’99camry CNG
Push the lever down in the “SET/COAST” direction and hold it. Release the lever
when the desired speed is attained. While the lever is held down, the vehicle speed
will gradually decrease.
However, a faster way to reset is to depress the brake pedal and then push the
lever down in the “SET/COAST” direction.
Even if you turn off the overdrive switch, with the cruise control on, engine braking
will not be applied because the cruise control is not cancelled. To decrease the
vehicle speed, reset to a slower speed with the cruise control lever or depress the
brake pedal. If you use the brake pedal, cruise control is cancelled.
RESUMING THE PRESET SPEED
If the preset speed is cancelled by pulling the control lever or by depressing the
brake pedal or clutch pedal, pushing the lever up in the “RES/ACC” direction will
restore the speed set prior to cancellation.
However, once the vehicle speed falls below about 40 km/h (25 mph), the preset
speed will not be resumed.
CRUISE CONTROL FAILURE WARNING
If the “CRUISE” indicator light in the instrument cluster flashes when using the
cruise control, press the “CRUISE ON·OFF” button to turn the system off and then
press it again to turn it on.
If any of the following conditions then occurs, there is some trouble in the cruise
control system.
The indicator light does not come on.
The indicator light flashes again.
The indicator light goes out after it comes on.
If this is the case, contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer and have your
vehicle inspected.
cxlv
’99camry CNG
Reference
Part
1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–7
Car audio system
Reference
Using your audio system
Car audio system operating hints
cxlvi
’99camry CNG
Using your audio system—
AM·FM
ETRbasics
radio/cassette player/compact disc auto changer controller
—Some
This section describes some of the basic features on Toyota audio systems. Some
information may not pertain to your system.
Your audio system works when the ignition key is in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
TURNING THE SYSTEM ON AND OFF
Push “VOL/PWR” to turn the audio system on and off.
Push “AM”, “FM”, “TAPE” or “CD” to turn on that function without pushing “VOL/
PWR”.
You can turn on each player by inserting a cassette tape or compact disc.
You can turn off each player by ejecting the cassette tape or compact disc. If the
audio system was previously off, then the entire audio system will be turned off
when you eject the cassette tape or compact disc. If the another function was
previously playing, it will come on again.
SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNCTIONS
Push “AM”, “FM”, “TAPE” or “CD” if the system is already on but you want to
switch from one function to another.
TONE AND BALANCE
For details about your system’s tone and balance controls, see the description of
your own system.
Tone
How good an audio program sounds to you is largely determined by the mix of the
treble and bass levels. In fact, different kinds of music and vocal programs usually
sound better with different mixes of treble and bass.
cxlvii
’99camry CNG
Balance
A good balance of the left and right stereo channels and of the front and rear
sound levels is also important.
Keep in mind that if you are listening to a stereo recording or broadcast, changing
the right/left balance will increase the volume of one group of sounds while decreasing the volume of another.
YOUR RADIO ANTENNA
NOTICE
Attaching the film (especially conductive or metallic type) on the rear glass
will noticeably reduce the sensitivity of the radio.
YOUR CASSETTE PLAYER
When you insert a cassette, the exposed tape should be to the right.
NOTICE
Do not oil any part of the player and do not insert anything other than
cassette tapes into the slot, or the tape player may be damaged.
—Controls and features
Details of specific buttons, controls and features are described in the alphabetical
listing that follows.
cxlviii
’99camry CNG
1 2 3 4 5 6 (Preset buttons)
These buttons are used to preset and tune in radio stations.
To preset a station to a button: Tune in the desired station (see “TUNE” button).
Push and hold down the button until you hear a beep—this will set the station to
the button. The button number will appear on the display.
To tune in to a preset station: Push the button for the station you want. The button
number and station frequency will appear on the display.
These systems can store one AM and two FM stations for each button (The display
will show “AM”, “FM1” or “FM2” when you push “AM” or “FM”).
(Eject button)
Push this button to eject a cassette.
After you turn the ignition to “LOCK”, you will be able to eject a cassette but you
will not be able to reinsert it.
(Reverse/Fast forward buttons)
Cassette Player
Push the fast forward button to fast forward a cassette tape. “FF” will appear on
the display. Push the reverse button to rewind a tape. “REW” will appear on the
display.
To stop the tape while it is fast forwarding, push the fast forward button or “TAPE”;
to stop the tape while it is rewinding, push the reverse button or “TAPE”.
If a tape side rewinds completely, the cassette player will stop and then play that
same side. If a tape fast forwards completely, the cassette player will play the other
side of the tape, using the auto–reverse feature.
Compact Disc Player
cxlix
’99camry CNG
If you want to fast forward or reverse through a compact disc track, push and hold
in the fast forward or reverse button. When you release the button, the compact
disc player will resume playing.
AM
Push “AM” to switch the AM band. “AM” will appear on the display.
If the audio system is off, you can turn on the radio by pushing “AM”. Also, push
“AM” to switch from cassette or compact disc operation to radio operation.
AUDIO CONTROL / MODE
Manual tone adjustment function—
This knob is used to adjust the tone manually.
For low–pitch tone adjustment, push “AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until
“BAS” appears on the display. Then turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from “BAS –5” to “BAS 5”.
For high–pitch tone adjustment, push “AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until
“TRE” appears on the display. Then turn the knob to suit your preference.
The display will show the range from “TRE –5” to “TRE 5”.
Sound balance adjustment function—
This knob is also used to adjust the sound balance between the front and rear, and
the right and left speakers.
For front/rear adjustment, push “AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until “FAd”
appears on the display. Then turn the knob to adjust the front/rear balance.
The display will show the range from “FAd F7” to “FAd R7”.
For left/right adjustment, push “AUDIO CONTROL / MODE” repeatedly until “BAL”
appears on the display. Then turn the knob to adjust the left/right balance.
cl
’99camry CNG
The display will show the range from “BAL L7” to “BAL R7”.
CD (Compact Disc)
Push “CD” to switch from radio or cassette operation to compact disc operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn on the compact disc player by pushing
“CD”. In both cases, a disc must already be loaded in the player.
When the audio is set into compact disc operation, the display shows the track or,
track and disc number currently being played. Each time you push “CD”, the system
changes between single disc player and automatic changer.
If the player malfunctions, your audio system will display one of the six following
error messages.
If “WAIT” appears on the display, it indicates inside the player unit may be too
hot due to the very high ambient temperature. Remove the disc or magazine from
the player and allow the player to cool down.
If “Err 1” appears on the display, it indicates the disc is dirty, damaged, or it
was inserted up–side down. Clean the disc or insert it correctly.
If “Err 2” appears on the display, it indicates no disc is loaded inside the
magazine, insert a disc.
If “Err 3” or “Err 4” on the display, it indicates there is a trouble inside the
system. Eject the disc or magazine. Set the disc or magazine again.
If “OPEn” appears on the display, it indicates the compact disc auto changer lid
is open. Close the compact disc auto changer lid.
If the malfunction is not rectified, take your vehicle to your authorized Toyota
CNG dealer.
DISC
Compact disc auto changer only—
cli
’99camry CNG
By using this button, you can select a disc you wish to listen to.
Push either side of the button until the number of the disc you want to listen to
appears on the display.
Dolby
B NR∗
If you are listening to a tape that was recorded with Dolby B Noise Reduction,
push the button marked with the double–D symbol. The double–D symbol will appear
on the display. Push the button again to turn off Dolby B NR.
The Dolby NR mode reduces tape noise by about 10 dB. For best sound reproduction, play your tapes with this button on or off according to the mode used for
recording the tape.
∗ : Dolby noise reduction manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. “DOLBY” and
the double D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation.
FM
Push “FM” to switch the FM band. “FM1” or “FM2” will appear on the display. This
system allows you to set twelve FM stations, two for each button.
If the audio system is off, you can turn on the radio by pushing “FM”. Also, push
“FM” to switch from cassette or compact disc operation to radio operation.
PROG (Program)
Push “PROG” to select the other side of a cassette tape. The display indicates
which side is currently selected (“
” indicates top side, “ ” indicates bottom
side).
Auto–reverse feature: After the cassette player reaches the end of a tape side, it
automatically reverses and begins to play the other side. This is true whether the
cassette was playing or fast forwarding.
RAND (Random)
clii
’99camry CNG
There are two random features—you can either listen to the tracks on all the
compact discs in the magazine in random order, or only listen to the tracks on a
specific compact disc in random order.
Random playing for the tracks on a disc: Quickly push and release “RAND”. “RAND”
will appear on the display. The disc you are listening to will play in random order.
If you hear a beep, you held the button too long, and the player will play all the
tracks in the magazine in random order. To turn off the random feature, push the
“RAND” a second time.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Random playing for all the tracks in the magazine:
Push and hold “RAND” until you hear a beep. “D·RAND” will appear on the display
and the player will perform all the tracks on all the discs in the magazine in random
order. To turn off the random feature, push “RAND” a second time.
RPT (Repeat)
There are two repeat features—you can either replay a disc track or a whole
compact disc.
Repeating a track:
Quickly push and release “RPT” while the track is playing. “RPT” will appear on
the display. If you hear a beep, you held the button too long, and the player will
repeat the whole disc. When the track ends, it will automatically be replayed. This
process will be continued until you push the button again to turn off the repeat
feature.
Compact disc auto changer only—
Repeating a disc:
Push and hold “RPT” until you hear a beep. “D·RPT” will appear on the display.
The player will repeat all the tracks on the disc you are listening to. When the disc
ends, the player will automatically go back to the top track of the disc and replay.
cliii
’99camry CNG
This process will be continued until you push the button again to turn off the repeat
feature.
SCAN
Radio
You can either scan all the frequencies on a band or scan only the preset stations
for that band.
To scan the preset stations:
Push and hold “SCAN” until you hear a beep. The radio will tune in the next preset
station up the band, stay there for a few seconds, and then move to the next preset
station. To select a station, push “SCAN” a second time.
To scan all the frequencies:
Quickly push and release “SCAN”. If you hear a beep, you held the button too long,
and the radio will scan the preset stations. The radio will find the next station up
the station band, stay there for a few seconds, and then scan again. To select a
station, push “SCAN” a second time.
Compact disc player
There are two scan features—you can either scan the tracks on a specific disc or
scan the first tracks of all the discs in the magazine.
Scanning for the tracks on a disc:
Quickly push and release “SCAN”. “SCAN” will appear on the display and the player
will scan all the tracks on the disc you are listening to. If you hear a beep, you
held the button too long, and the player will scan the first tracks of all the discs
in the magazine. To select a track, push the “SCAN” a second time. If the player
scanned all the tracks on the disc, it will stop scanning.
Compact disc auto changer only—
cliv
’99camry CNG
Scanning for the first tracks of all the discs in the magazine:
Push and hold “SCAN” until you hear a beep. “D·SCAN” will appear on the display
and the player will perform the first track of the next disc. To select a disc, push
the “SCAN” a second time. If the player has scanned all the discs, it will stop
scanning.
ST (Stereo reception) display
Your radio automatically changes to stereo reception when a stereo broadcast is
received. “ST” appears on the display. If the signal becomes weak, the radio
reduces the amount of channel separation to prevent the weak signal from creating
noise. If the signal becomes extremely weak, the radio switches from stereo to
mono reception.
TAPE
Push “TAPE” to switch from radio or compact disc operation to cassette operation.
If the audio system is off, you can turn on the cassette player by pushing “TAPE”.
In both cases, a cassette must already be loaded in the player.
TRACK (Track up/down button): Compact disc player
By using this button, you can skip up or down to a different track.
Push either side of the track button until the number of the track you want to listen
to appears on the display. If you want to return to the beginning of the current
track, push the down side of the button one time, quickly.
TUNE
Tuning
Your Toyota has an electronic tuning radio (ETR). Push and release the “” (up)
or “” (down) side of “TUNE” to step up or down the station band. (If you hear
a beep, you held the button too long and the radio will go into the seek mode.)
clv
’99camry CNG
Car audio system operating
Seeking
hints
In the seek mode, the radio finds and plays the next station up or down the station
band.
To seek a station, push and hold the “” or “” side of “TUNE” until you hear
a beep. Do this again to find another station.
VOL/PWR (Volume/Power)
Push “VOL/PWR” to turn the audio system on and off. Turn “VOL/PWR” to adjust
the volume.
NOTICE
To ensure the correct audio system operation:
Be careful not to spill beverages over the audio system.
Do not put anything other than a cassette tape into the slot.
The use of cellular phone inside or near the vehicle may cause a noise
from the speakers of the audio system which you are listening to. However, this does not indicate a malfunction.
RADIO RECEPTION
Usually, a problem with radio reception does not mean there is a problem with your
radio—it is just the normal result of conditions outside the vehicle.
For example, nearby buildings and terrain can interfere with FM reception. Power
lines or telephone wires can interfere with AM signals. And of course, radio signals
have a limited range, and the farther you are from a station, the weaker its signal
will be. In addition, reception conditions change constantly as your vehicle moves.
clvi
’99camry CNG
Here are some common reception problems that probably do not indicate a problem
with your radio:
FM
Fading and drifting stations—Generally, the effective range of FM is about 40 km
(25 miles). Once outside this range, you may notice fading and drifting, which
increase with the distance from the radio transmitter. They are often accompanied
by distortion.
Multi–path—FM signals are reflective, making it possible for two signals to reach
your antenna at the same time. If this happens, the signals will cancel each other
out, causing a momentary flutter or loss of reception.
Static and fluttering—These occur when signals are blocked by buildings, trees, or
other large objects. Increasing the bass level may reduce static and fluttering.
Station swapping—If the FM signal you are listening to is interrupted or weakened,
and there is another strong station nearby on the FM band, your radio may tune
in the second station until the original signal can be picked up again.
AM
Fading—AM broadcasts are reflected by the upper atmosphere—especially at night.
These reflected signals can interfere with those received directly from the radio
station, causing the radio station to sound alternately strong and weak.
Station interference—When a reflected signal and a signal received directly from a
radio station are very nearly the same frequency, they can interfere with each other,
making it difficult to hear the broadcast.
Static—AM is easily affected by external sources of electrical noise, such as high
tension power lines, lightening, or electrical motors. This results in static.
CARING FOR YOUR CASSETTE PLAYER AND TAPES
For high performance from your cassette player and tapes:
clvii
’99camry CNG
Clean the tape head and other parts regularly.
A dirty tape head or tape path can decrease sound quality and tangle your
cassette tapes. The easiest way to clean them is by using a cleaning tape. (A
wet type is recommended.)
Use high–quality cassettes.
Low–quality cassette tapes can cause many problems, including poor sound,
inconsistent playing speed, and constant auto–reversing. They can also get stuck
or tangled in the cassette player.
Do not use a cassette if it has been damaged or tangled or if its label is peeling
off.
Do not leave a cassette in the player if you are not listening to it, especially
if it is hot outside.
Store cassettes in their cases and out of direct sunlight.
Avoid using cassettes with a total playing time longer than 100 minutes (50
minutes per side). The tape used in these cassettes is thin and could get stuck
or tangled in the cassette player.
clviii
’99camry CNG
clix
’99camry CNG
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–8
Air conditioning system
Controls
Air flow selector settings
Operating tips
Side vents
Controls
1. “A/C” Button
2. Air Intake Selector
3. Air Flow Selector
4. Temperature Selector
5. Fan Speed Selector
clx
’99camry CNG
Fan speed selector
Turn the knob to adjust the fan speed—to the right to increase, to the left to
decrease.
Temperature selector
Turn the knob to adjust the temperature—to the right to warm, to the left to cool.
Air flow selector
Turn the knob to select the vents used for air flow.
1. Panel—Air flows mainly from the instrument panel vents.
2. Bi–level—Air flows from both the floor vents and the instrument panel vents.
3. Floor—Air flows mainly from the floor vents.
4. Floor/Windshield—Air flows mainly from the floor vents and windshield vents.
Use with the air intake selector positioned in Fresh.
clxi
’99camry CNG
5. Windshield—Air flows mainly from the windshield vents.
Use with the air intake selector positioned in Fresh.
For details about air flow selector settings, see the illustration after “A/C” button.
Turning the Air Flow Selector to windshield position turns on the defroster to clear
the front view more quickly.
Air intake selector
Move the lever to select the air source.
1. Recirculate—Recirculates the air inside the vehicle.
2. Fresh—Draws outside air into the system.
“A/C” button
clxii
’99camry CNG
To turn on the air conditioning, press the “A/C” button. The “A/C” button indicator
will come on. To turn the air conditioning off, press the button again.
If the “A/C” button indicator flashes, there is a problem in the air conditioning
system and the air conditioning automatically shuts off. If this happens, take your
vehicle to your authorized Toyota CNG dealer for service.
Air flow selector settings
Operating tips
To cool off your Toyota after it has been parked in the hot sun, drive with the
windows open for a few minutes. This vents the hot air, allowing the air conditioning to cool the interior more quickly.
Make sure the air intake grilles in front of the windshield are not blocked (by
leaves or snow, for example).
On humid days, do not blow cold air on the windshield. The windshield could
fog up because of the difference in air temperature on the inside and outside
of the windshield.
Keep the area under the front seats clear to allow air to circulate throughout
the vehicle.
On cold days, move the fan speed to “HI” for a minute to help clear the intake
ducts of snow or moisture. This can reduce the amount of fogging on the
windows.
When driving on dusty roads, close all windows. If dust thrown up by the vehicle
is still drawn into the vehicle after closing the windows, it is recommended that
the air intake selector be set to FRESH and the fan speed selector to any
setting except “OFF”.
clxiii
’99camry CNG
If following another vehicle on a dusty road, or driving in windy and dusty
conditions, it is recommended that the air intake selector be temporarily set to
RECIRCULATE, which will close off the outside passage and prevent outside air
and dust from entering the vehicle interior.
Heating
For best results, set controls to:
Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”
Temperature—Towards WARM
(red zone)
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—FLOOR
Air conditioning—OFF
For quick heating, select recirculated air for a few minutes. To keep the windows
from fogging, select fresh after the vehicle interior has been warmed.
Press the “A/C” button on for dehumidified heating.
Choose floor/windshield air flow to heat the vehicle interior while defrosting or
defogging the windshield.
Air conditioning
For best results, set controls to:
Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”
Temperature—Towards COLD
(blue zone)
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—PANEL
Air conditioning—ON
clxiv
’99camry CNG
For quick cooling, move the air intake selector to recirculate for a few minutes.
Ventilation
For best results, set controls to:
Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”
Temperature—Towards COLD
(blue zone)
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—PANEL
Air conditioning—OFF
Defogging
The inside of the windshield
For best results, set controls to:
Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”
Temperature—Towards WARM
(red zone) to heat;
COLD (blue zone) to
cool
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—WINDSHIELD
Turning the Air Flow Selector to windshield position turns on the defroster to clear
the front view more quickly.
Press the “A/C” button for dehumidified heating or cooling. This setting clears the
front view more quickly.
On humid days, do not blow cold air on the windshield—the difference between
the outside and inside temperatures could make the fogging worse.
clxv
’99camry CNG
Defrosting
The outside of the windshield
For best results, set controls to:
Fan speed—Any setting except “OFF”
Temperature—Towards WARM
(red zone)
Air intake—FRESH (outside air)
Air flow—WINDSHIELD
Turning the Air Flow Selector to windshield position turns on the defroster to clear
the front view more quickly.
Press the “A/C” button for dehumidified heating. This setting clears the front view
more quickly.
To heat the vehicle interior while defrosting the windshield, choose floor/windshield air flow.
Side vents
clxvi
’99camry CNG
If air flow control is not satisfactory, check the side vents. The side vents may be
opened or closed as shown.
clxvii
’99camry CNG
clxviii
’99camry CNG
Part 1
OPERATION OF
INSTRUMENTS AND
CONTROLS—
Chapter 1–9
Other equipment
Clock
Cigarette lighter and ashtrays
Power outlet
Glove box
Garage door opener box
Miscellaneous box
Auxiliary box
Cup holder
Floor mat
Clock
clxix
’99camry CNG
The digital clock indicates the time.
The key must be in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
To reset the hour: Push the “H” button.
To reset the minutes: Push the “M” button.
If the electrical power source has been disconnected from the clock, the time
display will automatically be set to 1:00 (one o’clock).
If quick adjustment to a full hour is desired, push the “:00” button.
For example, if the “:00” button is depressed when the time is between 1:01—1:29,
the time will change to 1:00. If the time is between 1:30—1:59, the time will change
to 2:00.
When the instrument panel lights are turned on, the brightness of the time indication
will be reduced.
Cigarette lighter and ashtrays
clxx
’99camry CNG
Cigarette lighter and front ashtray
Rear ashtray (on some models)
clxxi
’99camry CNG
CIGARETTE LIGHTER
To use the cigarette lighter, press it in. When it becomes heated, it automatically pops out ready for use.
If the engine is not running, the key must be in the “ACC” position.
Do not hold the cigarette lighter pressed in.
Use a Toyota genuine cigarette lighter or equivalent for replacement.
ASHTRAYS
To use the ashtray, open out.
When finished with your cigarette, thoroughly extinguish it in the ashtray to prevent
other cigarette butts from catching fire. After using the ashtray, push it back in
completely.
To remove the ashtray, press down on the lock spring plate and pull out.
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in case of an accident or sudden stop while
driving, always push the ashtray back in completely after use.
Power outlet
clxxii
’99camry CNG
The power outlet is designed for power supply for car accessories.
The key must be in the “ACC” or “ON” position for the power outlet to be used.
NOTICE
To prevent the fuse from being blown, do not use the electricity over the
total vehicle capacity of 12V/120W.
To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not use the power outlet
longer than necessary when the engine is not running.
Close the power outlet lid when the power outlet is not in use. Inserting
a foreign object other than the appropriate plug that fits the outlet, or
allowing any liquid into the outlet may cause electrical failure or short
circuits.
clxxiii
’99camry CNG
Glove box
To use the glove box, do this.
To open: Pull the lever.
With the instrument panel lights on, the glove box light will come on when the glove
box is open.
To lock: Insert the master key and turn it clockwise.
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in case of an accident or a sudden stop,
always keep the glove box door closed while driving.
Garage door opener box
clxxiv
’99camry CNG
The box is designed to store a garage door opener transmitter.
Open the cover and remove the Velcro loop.
clxxv
’99camry CNG
Remove the paper strip covering the adhesive on back side of loop and adhere loop
to back side of the transmitter near center.
Please note if transmitter has wire clip for sun visor, this clip must be removed
prior to adhesion of the Velcro.
clxxvi
’99camry CNG
Place the transmitter with Velcro loop facing inside of box into the box. Make sure
the transmitter button is located above button pins.
clxxvii
’99camry CNG
Remove spacers from the center panel. Place the largest spacer on the pin that
would be below transmitter button when the cover is closed. Close the cover.
When the garage door opener transmitter is properly installed, you can operate the
transmitter by pushing the center panel of the cover.
clxxviii
’99camry CNG
If the center panel does not contact with your garage door opener transmitter:
Check to see if spacer is on correct pin.
Attach another spacer to the top of original spacer. Check operation. If required,
continue add spacers until contact is achieved.
If the transmitter is clattering during driving, fill in a piece of felt or pad to prevent
the transmitter from clattering.
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in case of an accident or a sudden stop,
always keep the garage door opener box closed while driving.
Keep the remained spacers away from children.
clxxix
’99camry CNG
The miscellaneous box and garage door opener box (stored in the glove box)
are interchangeable.
Removing the cover—
Half open the cover. Pinch each hinge and pull it out of its pivot one by one as
shown above.
Do not remove the cover forcibly.
clxxx
’99camry CNG
Installing the cover—
Align the hinges to the pivots, and press each hinge with a thumb until you hear
a click.
Make sure that the cover opens and closes smoothly.
Miscellaneous box
clxxxi
’99camry CNG
To use the box, open it as shown above.
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in case of an accident or a sudden stop,
always keep the miscellaneous box closed while driving.
NOTICE
In hot weather, inside of the vehicle becomes very hot. Do not leave anything
flammable or deformable such as a lighter, the glasses, etc. inside.
Auxiliary box
clxxxii
’99camry CNG
To use the box, pull on the handle.
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of injury in case of an accident or a sudden stop,
always keep the auxiliary box closed while driving.
Cup holder
clxxxiii
’99camry CNG
Front
Rear
clxxxiv
’99camry CNG
The cup holder is designed for holding cups or drink–cans securely in its
holes.
Front: To use the holder, open the lid.
Rear: To use the holder, pull it out.
CAUTION
Do not place anything else other than cups or drink–cans on the cup
holder, as such items may be thrown about in the compartment and
possibly injure people in the vehicle during sudden braking or in an
accident.
To reduce the chance of injury in case of an accident or sudden stop while
driving, keep the cup holder closed when it is not in use.
Floor mat
clxxxv
’99camry CNG
Use a floor mat of the correct size.
If the floor carpet and floor mat have a hole, then it is designed for use with a
locking clip. Fix the floor mat with locking clip into the hole in the floor carpet.
CAUTION
Make sure the floor mat is properly placed on the floor carpet. If the floor
mat slips and interferes with the movement of the pedals during driving, it
may cause an accident.
clxxxvi
’99camry CNG
Part 7
DO–IT–YOURSELF
MAINTENANCE—
Chapter 7–1
Introduction
Engine compartment overview
Fuse locations
Do–it–yourself service
precautions
Parts and tools
Engine compartment overview
1. Power steering fluid reservoir
2. Engine coolant reservoir
3. Engine oil filler cap
4. Engine oil level dipstick
5. Brake fluid reservoir
cclxxxii
’99camry CNG
6. Fuse blocks
7. Battery
8. Electric cooling fans
9. Windshield washer fluid tank
Fuse locations
cclxxxiii
’99camry CNG
cclxxxiv
’99camry CNG
Spare fuses
cclxxxv
’99camry CNG
Do–it–yourself service
precautions
If you perform maintenance by yourself, be sure to follow the correct procedure given in this part.
You should be aware that improper or incomplete servicing may result in operating
problems.
Performing do–it–yourself maintenance during the warranty period may affect your
warranty coverage. Read the separate Toyota Warranty statement for details and
suggestions.
This part gives instructions only for those items that are relatively easy for an
owner to perform. As explained in Part 6, there are still a number of items that
must be done by a qualified technician with special tools.
For information on tools and parts for do–it–yourself maintenance, see “Parts and
tools”.
Utmost care should be taken when working on your vehicle to prevent accidental
injury. Here are a few precautions that you should be especially careful to observe:
cclxxxvi
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Never work on the fuel system by yourself. Any work on this system must
be performed by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer. If an unqualified
person works on it incorrectly causing fuel leaks etc., a fire hazard or
explosion may occur, which is very dangerous.
When the engine is running, keep hands, clothing, and tools away from
the moving fan and engine drive belts. (Removing rings, watches, and ties
is advisable.)
Right after driving, the engine compartment—the engine, radiator, exhaust
manifold and spark plug boots, etc.—will be hot. So be careful not to
touch them. Oil, fluids and spark plugs may also be hot.
If the engine is hot, do not remove the radiator cap or loosen the drain
plugs to prevent burning yourself.
Do not smoke, cause sparks or allow open flames around fuel or the
battery. Their fumes are flammable.
cclxxxvii
’99camry CNG
Be extremely cautious when working on the battery. It contains poisonous
and corrosive sulfuric acid.
Do not get under your vehicle with just the body jack supporting it. Always
use automotive jack stands or other solid supports.
Be sure that the ignition is off if you work near the electric cooling fans
or radiator grille. With the ignition on, the electric cooling fans will automatically start to run if the engine coolant temperature is high and/or the
air conditioning is on.
Use eye protection whenever you work on or under your vehicle where you
may be exposed to flying or falling material, fluid spray, etc.
Used engine oil contains potentially harmful contaminants which may cause
skin disorders such as inflammation or skin cancer, so care should be
taken to avoid prolonged and repeated contact with it. To remove used
engine oil from your skin, wash thoroughly with soap and water.
Do not leave used oil within the reach of children.
Dispose of used oil and filter only in a safe and acceptable manner. Do
not dispose of used oil and filter in household trash, in sewers or onto
the ground. Call your authorized Toyota CNG dealer or a service station
for information concerning recycling or disposal.
cclxxxviii
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Remember that battery and ignition cables carry high currents or voltages.
Be careful of accidentally causing a short circuit.
Be careful not to touch the fuel pipe unintentionally. If an excessive force
is applied on the pipe, gas may leak from its connections.
Add only demineralized or distilled water to fill the radiator. And if you
spill some of the coolant, be sure to wash off with water to prevent it from
damaging the parts or paint.
Do not allow dirt or anything else to fall through the spark plugholes.
Use only spark plugs of the specified type. Using other types will cause
engine damage, loss of performance or radio noise.
Do not reuse platinum–tipped spark plugs by cleaning or regapping.
Do not overfill automatic transmission fluid, or the transmission could be
damaged.
Do not drive with the air cleaner filter removed, or excessive engine wear
could result. Also backfiring could cause a fire in the engine compartment.
Be careful not to scratch the glass surface with the wiper frame.
When closing the engine hood, check to see that you have not forgotten
any tools, rags, etc.
Parts and tools
Here is a list of parts and tools you will need on performing do–it–yourself maintenance. Remember all Toyota parts are designed in metric sizes, so your tools must
be metric.
cclxxxix
’99camry CNG
Checking the engine oil level
Parts (if level is low):
Engine
oil
API
grade
SJ,
“Energy–Conserving” or ILSAC multigrade having viscosity proper for your climate
Tools:
Rag or paper towel
Funnel (only for adding oil)
Checking the engine coolant level
Parts (if level is low):
“TOYOTA Long Life Coolant” or equivalent
See Chapter 7–2 for details about coolant type selection.
Demineralized or distilled water
Tools:
Funnel (only for adding coolant)
Checking brake fluid
Parts (if level is low):
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3 brake fluid
Tools:
Rag or paper towel
Funnel (only for adding fluid)
Checking power steering fluid
Parts (if level is low):
Automatic
DEXRONII or III
transmission
fluid
Tools:
Rag or paper towel
Funnel (only for adding fluid)
ccxc
’99camry CNG
Checking battery condition
Tools:
Warm water
Baking soda
Grease
Conventional wrench (for terminal clamp bolts)
Checking and replacing fuses
Parts (if replacement is necessary):
Genuine Toyota fuse or equivalent with same amperage rating as original
Adding washer fluid
Parts:
Water
Washer fluid containing antifreeze (for winter use)
Tools:
Funnel
Replacing light bulbs
Parts:
Bulb with same number and wattage rating as original (See charts in “Replacing
light bulbs” in Chapter 7–3.)
Tools:
Screwdriver
Flat–bladed screwdriver
ccxci
’99camry CNG
Part 7
DO–IT–YOURSELF
MAINTENANCE—
Chapter 7–2
Engine and Chassis
Checking the engine oil level
Checking the engine coolant
level
Checking brake fluid
Checking power steering fluid
Checking tire pressure
Checking and replacing tires
Rotating tires
Installing snow tires and chains
Replacing wheels
Checking the engine oil level
ccxcii
’99camry CNG
Low level
Add oil
Full level
O.K.
Too full
With the engine at operating temperature and turned off, check the oil level
on the dipstick.
1. To get a true reading, the vehicle should be on a level spot. After turning off
the engine, wait a few minutes for the oil to drain back into the bottom of the
engine.
2. Pull out the dipstick, and wipe it clean with a rag.
3. Reinsert the dipstick—push it in as far as it will go, or the reading will not be
correct.
4. Pull the dipstick out and look at the oil level on the end.
CAUTION
Be careful not to touch the hot exhaust manifold.
ccxciii
’99camry CNG
If the oil level is below or only slightly above the low level line, add engine
oil of the same type as already in the engine.
Remove the oil filler cap and add engine oil in small quantities at a time, checking
the dipstick.
The approximate quantity of oil needed to fill between the low level and the full
level on the dipstick is indicated below for reference.
When the level reaches within the correct range, install the filler cap hand–tight.
Oil quantity, L (qt., lmp. qt.):
0.7 (0.7, 0.6)
NOTICE
Avoid overfilling, or the engine could be damaged.
Check the oil level on the dipstick once again after adding the oil.
Engine oil selection
Use API grade SJ, “Energy–Conserving” or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity (SAE):
ccxciv
’99camry CNG
SAE 5W–30 is the best choice for your vehicle, for good fuel economy, and
good starting in cold weather.
If you use SAE 10W–30 engine oil in extremely low temperatures, the engine
may become difficult to start, so SAE 5W–30engine oil is recommended.
API service symbol
ccxcv
’99camry CNG
Checking the engine coolant
level
ILSAC certification mark
Oil identification marks
Either or both API registered marks are added to some oil containers to help
you select the oil you should use.
The API Service Symbol is located anywhere on the outside of the container.
The top portion of the label shows the oil quality by API (American Petroleum
Institute) designations such as SJ. The center portion of the label shows the SAE
viscosity grade such as SAE 5W–30. “Energy–Conserving” shown in the lower
portion, indicates that the oil has fuel–saving capabilities.
The ILSAC (International Lubricant Standardization and Approval Committee) Certification Mark is displayed on the front of the container.
Look at the see–through coolant reservoir when the engine is cold. The coolant
level is satisfactory if it is between the “FULL” and “LOW” lines on the
ccxcvi
’99camry CNG
reservoir. If the level is low, add ethylene–glycol type coolant for a proper
corrosion protection of aluminum components.
The coolant level in the reservoir will vary with engine temperature. However, if the
level is on or below the “LOW” line, add coolant. Bring the level up to the “FULL”
line.
Always use ethylene–glycol type coolant for a proper corrosion protection of aluminum components. See information in the next column.
If the coolant level drops within a short time after replenishing, there may be a leak
in the system. Visually check the radiator, hoses, radiator cap and drain cock and
water pump.
If you can find no leak, have your authorized Toyota CNG dealer test the cap
pressure and check for leaks in the cooling system.
CAUTION
To prevent burning yourself, do not remove the radiator cap when the engine
is hot.
Coolant type selection
Use of improper coolants may damage your engine cooling system. Your coolant
must contain ethylene–glycol type coolant for a proper corrosion protection of your
engine that contains aluminum components. Use “TOYOTA Long Life Coolant” or
equivalent.
In addition to preventing freezing and subsequent damage to the engine, this type of
coolant will also prevent corrosion. Further supplemental inhibitors or additives are
neither needed nor recommended.
Read the coolant container for information on freeze protection. Follow the manufacturer’s directions for how much to mix with plain water (preferably demineralized
ccxcvii
’99camry CNG
water or distilled water). The total capacity of the cooling system is given in Part
8.
We recommend to use 50% solution for your Toyota, to provide protection down to
about –35C (–31F). When it is extremely cold, to provide protection down to about
–50°C (–58°F), 60% solution is recommended. Do not use more than 70% solution
for better coolant performance.
NOTICE
Do not use alcohol type antifreeze or plain water alone.
Checking brake fluid
To check the fluid level, simply look at the see–through reservoir. The level
should be between the “MAX” and “MIN” lines on the reservoir.
ccxcviii
’99camry CNG
It is normal for the brake fluid level to go down slightly as the brake pads wear.
So be sure to keep the reservoir filled.
If the reservoir needs frequent refilling, it may indicate a serious mechanical problem.
If the level is low, add SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3 brake fluid to the
brake reservoir.
Remove and replace the reservoir cover by hand.
Use only newly opened brake fluid. Once opened, brake fluid absorbs moisture from
the air, and excess moisture can cause a dangerous loss of braking.
CAUTION
Take care when filling the reservoir because brake fluid can harm your eyes
and damage painted surfaces. If fluid gets in your eyes, flush your eyes with
clean water.
NOTICE
If you spill some of the fluid, be sure to wash it off with water to prevent
it from damaging the parts or paint.
Checking power steering fluid
ccxcix
’99camry CNG
Open
If hot
O.K.
Close
If cold
O.K.
If cold
add
If hot
add
Check the fluid level through the reservoir. If necessary, add automatic transmission fluid DEXRONII or III.
If the vehicle has been driven around 80 km/h (50 mph) for 20 minutes (a little
more in frigid temperatures), the fluid is hot (60C—80C or 140F—175F). You
may also check the level when the fluid is cold (about room temperature,
10C—30C or 50F—85F) if the engine has not been run for about five hours.
Clean all dirt from outside of the reservoir tank and look at the fluid level. If the
fluid is cold, the level should be in the “COLD” range. Similarly, if it is hot, the
fluid level should be in the “HOT” range. If the level is at the low side of either
range, add automatic transmission fluid DEXRONII or III to bring the level within
the range.
To remove the filler cap, turn it counterclockwise and lift up. To reinstall it, turn
it clockwise. After replacing the filler cap, visually check the steering box case,
vane pump and hose connections for leaks or damage.
ccc
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
The reservoir tank may be hot so be careful not to burn yourself.
NOTICE
Avoid overfilling, or the power steering could be damaged.
Checking tire pressure
Keep your tire pressures at the proper level.
The recommended cold tire pressures, tire size and the vehicle capacity weight are
given in Part 8. They are also on the tire pressure label as shown.
You should check the tire pressures every two weeks, or at least once a month.
And don’t forget the spare!
ccci
’99camry CNG
Incorrect tire pressure can reduce tire life and make your vehicle less safe to
drive.
Low tire pressure results in excessive wear, poor handling, reduced fuel economy,
and the possibility of blowouts from overheated tires. Also, low tire pressure can
cause poor sealing of the tire bead. If the tire pressure is excessively low, there
is the possibility of wheel deformation and/or tire separation.
High tire pressure produces a harsh ride, handling problems, excessive wear at the
center of the tire tread, and a greater possibility of tire damage from road hazards.
If a tire frequently needs refilling, have it checked by your authorized Toyota CNG
dealer.
The following instructions for checking tire pressure should be observed:
The pressure should be checked only when the tires are cold. If your vehicle
has been parked for at least 3 hours and has not been driven for more than
1.5 km or 1 mile since, you will get an accurate cold tire pressure reading.
Always use a tire pressure gauge. The appearance of a tire can be misleading.
Besides, tire pressures that are even just a few pounds off can degrade handling
and ride.
Take special care when adding air to the compact spare tire. The smaller
tire size can gain pressure very quickly. Add compressed air in small quantities
and check the pressure often until it reaches the specified pressure.
Do not bleed or reduce tire pressure after driving. It is normal for the tire
pressure to be higher after driving.
Never exceed the vehicle capacity weight. The passenger and luggage weight
should be located so that the vehicle is balanced.
cccii
’99camry CNG
Be sure to reinstall the tire inflation valve caps. Without the valve caps, dirt
or moisture could get into the valve core and cause air leakage. If the caps have
been lost, have new ones put on as soon as possible.
Checking and replacing tires
Tread wear indicator
CHECKING YOUR TIRES
Check the tires tread for the tread wear indicators. If the indicators show,
replace the tires.
The tires on your Toyota have built–in tread wear indicators to help you know when
the tires need replacement. When the tread depth wears to 1.6 mm (0.06 in.) or
less, the indicators will appear. If you can see the indicators in two or more
adjacent grooves, the tire should be replaced. The lower the tread, the higher the
risk of skidding.
The effectiveness of snow tires is lost if the tread wears down below 4 mm
(0.16 in.).
ccciii
’99camry CNG
Check the tires regularly for damage such as cuts, splits and cracks. If any
damage is found, consult with a technician and have the tire repaired or
replaced.
Even if the damage does not appear serious, a qualified technician should examine
the damage. Objects which have penetrated the tire may have caused internal
damage.
Any tires which are over 6 years old must be checked by a qualified technician
even if damage is not obvious.
Tires deteriorate with age even if they have never or seldom been used.
This applies also to the spare tire and tires stored for future use.
REPLACING YOUR TIRES
When replacing a tire, use only the same size and construction as originally
installed and with the same or greater load capacity.
Using any other size or type of tire may seriously affect handling, ride, speedometer/odometer calibration, ground clearance, and clearance between the body and
tires or snow chains.
CAUTION
Do not mix radial, bias belted, or bias–ply tires on your vehicle. It can
cause dangerous handling characteristics, resulting in loss of control.
Do not use tires or wheels other than the manufacturer’s recommended
size.
Toyota recommends all four tires, or at least both of the front or rear tires
be replaced at a time as a set.
See “If you have a flat tire” in Part 4 for tire change procedure.
ccciv
’99camry CNG
When a tire is replaced, the wheel should always be balanced.
An unbalanced wheel may affect vehicle handling and tire life. Wheels can get out
of balance with regular use and should therefore be balanced occasionally.
When replacing a tubeless tire, the air valve should also be replaced with a
new one.
Rotating tires
To equalize the wear and help extend tire life, Toyota recommends that you
rotate your tires approximately every 12000 km (7500 miles). However, the most
appropriate timing for tire rotation may vary according to your driving habits
and road surface conditions.
See “If you have a flat tire” in Part 4 for tire change procedure.
When rotating tires, check for uneven wear and damage. Abnormal wear is usually
caused by incorrect tire pressure, improper wheel alignment, out–of–balance wheels,
or severe braking.
cccv
’99camry CNG
Installing snow tires and
chains
CAUTION
Do not include a compact spare tire when rotating the tires. It is designed
for temporary use only.
WHEN TO USE SNOW TIRES OR CHAINS
Snow tires or chains are recommended when driving on snow or ice.
On wet or dry roads, conventional tires provide better traction than snow tires.
SNOW TIRE SELECTION
If you need snow tires, select the same size, construction and load capacity
as the original tires on your Toyota.
Do not use tires other than those mentioned above. Do not install studded tires
without first checking local regulations for possible restrictions.
SNOW TIRE INSTALLATION
Snow tires should be installed on all wheels.
Installing snow tires on the front wheels only can lead to an excessive difference
in road grip capability between the front and rear tires which could cause loss of
vehicle control.
When storing removed tires you should store them in a cool dry place. Mark the
direction of rotation and be sure to install them in the same direction when replacing.
cccvi
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not drive with the snow tires incorrectly inflated.
Never drive over 120 km/h (75 mph) with any type of snow tires.
TIRE CHAIN SELECTION
Use the tire chains of correct size and type.
Use SAE Class “S” type radial tire chains except radial cable chains or V–bar type
chains.
Regulations regarding the use of tire chains vary according to location or type
of road, so always check them before installing chains.
CHAIN INSTALLATION
Install the chains on the front tires as tightly as possible. Do not use tire
chains on the rear tires. Retighten chains after driving 0.5—1.0 km (1/4—1/2
mile).
When installing chains on your tires, carefully follow the instructions of the chain
manufacturer.
If wheel covers are used, they will be scratched by the chain band,so remove the
covers before putting on the chains.
cccvii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not exceed 50 km/h (30 mph) or the chain manufacturer’s recommended
speed limit, whichever is lower.
Drive carefully avoiding bumps, holes, and sharp turns, which may cause
the vehicle to bounce.
Avoid sharp turns or locked–wheel braking, as use of chains may adversely
affect vehicle handling.
NOTICE
Do not attempt to use a tire chain on the compact spare tire, as it may
result in damage to the vehicle as well as the tire.
Replacing wheels
WHEN TO REPLACE YOUR WHEELS
If you have wheel damage such as bending, cracks or heavy corrosion, the
wheel should be replaced.
If you fail to replace damaged wheels, the tire may slip off the wheel or they may
cause loss of handling control.
WHEEL SELECTION
When replacing wheels, care should be taken to ensure that the wheels are
replaced by ones with the same load capacity, diameter, rim width, and offset.
This must be observed on compact spare tires, too.
Correct replacement wheels are available at your authorized Toyota CNG dealer.
A wheel of a different size or type may adversely affect handling, wheel and bearing
life, brake cooling, speedometer/odometer calibration, stopping ability, headlight aim,
cccviii
’99camry CNG
bumper height, vehicle ground clearance, and tire or snow chain clearance to the
body and chassis.
Replacement with used wheels is not recommended as they may have been subjected to rough treatment or high mileage and could fail without warning. Also, bent
wheels which have been straightened may have structural damage and therefore
should not be used. Never use an inner tube in a leaking wheel which is designed
for a tubeless tire.
cccix
’99camry CNG
cccx
’99camry CNG
Checking battery condition—
—Precautions
Part
7
DO–IT–YOURSELF
MAINTENANCE—
Chapter 7–3
Electrical components
Checking battery condition
Battery recharging precautions
Checking and replacing fuses
Adding washer fluid
Replacing light bulbs
cccxi
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
BATTERY PRECAUTIONS
The battery produces flammable and explosive hydrogen gas.
Do not cause a spark from the battery with tools.
Do not smoke or light a match near the battery.
The electrolyte contains poisonous and corrosive sulfuric acid.
Avoid contact with eyes, skin or clothes.
Never ingest electrolyte.
Wear protective safety glasses when working near the battery.
Keep children away from the battery.
EMERGENCY MEASURES
If electrolyte gets in your eyes, flush your eyes with clean water immediately and get immediate medical attention. If possible, continue to apply
water with a sponge or cloth while en route to the medical office.
If electrolyte gets on your skin, thoroughly wash the contact area. If you
feel pain or burning, get medical attention immediately.
If electrolyte gets on your clothes, there is a possibility of its soaking
through to your skin, so immediately take off the exposed clothing and
follow the procedure above, if necessary.
If you happen to swallow electrolyte, drink a large quantity of water or
milk. Follow with milk of magnesia, beaten raw egg or vegetable oil. Then
go immediately for emergency help.
cccxii
’99camry CNG
—Checking battery exterior
Terminals
Ground cable
Hold–down clamp
Check the battery for corroded or loose terminal connections, cracks, or loose
hold–down clamp.
a. If the battery is corroded, wash it off with a solution of warm water and baking
soda. Coat the outside of the terminals with grease to prevent further corrosion.
b. If the terminal connections are loose, tighten their clamp nuts—but do not overtighten.
c. Tighten the hold–down clamp only enough to keep the battery firmly in place.
Overtightening may damage the battery case.
cccxiii
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Be sure the engine and all accessories are off before performing maintenance.
When checking the battery, remove the ground cable from the negative
terminal (“–” mark) first and reinstall it last.
Be careful not to cause a short circuit with tools.
Take care no solution gets into the battery when washing it.
—Checking battery fluid
Type A
Dark
Clear or
light yellow
White
Red
Green
Type B
Blue
CHECKING BY THE HYDROMETER
Check the battery condition by the hydrometer color.
Hydrometer color
Type A
Type B
Condition
cccxiv
’99camry CNG
GREEN
BLUE
DARK
WHITE
CLEAR or
LIGHT
YELLOW
RED
Good
Charging necessary.
Have battery
checked by your
authorized Toyota
CNG dealer.
Have battery
checked by your
authorized Toyota
CNG dealer.
Battery recharging precautions
During recharging, the battery is producing hydrogen gas.
Therefore, before recharging:
1. If recharging with the battery installed on the vehicle, be sure to disconnect the
ground cable.
2. Be sure the power switch on the recharger is off when connecting the charger
cables to the battery and when disconnecting them.
CAUTION
Always charge the battery in an unconfined area. Do not charge the battery
in a garage or closed room where there is not sufficient ventilation.
Only do a slow charge (5 A or less). Charging at a quicker rate is
dangerous. The battery may explode, causing personal injuries.
cccxv
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Never recharge the battery while the engine is running. Also, be sure all
accessories are turned off.
Checking and replacing fuses
cccxvi
’99camry CNG
Type A
Good
Blown
Type B
Good
Blown
Type C
Good
Blown
cccxvii
’99camry CNG
If the headlights or other electrical components do not work, check the fuses.
If any of the fuses are blown, they must be replaced.
See “Fuse locations” in Chapter 7–1 for locations of the fuses.
Turn the ignition switch and inoperative component off. Pull a suspected fuse
straight out and check it.
Determine which fuse may be causing the problem. The lid of the fuse box shows
the name of the circuit for each fuse. See Part 8 of this manual for the functions
controlled by each circuit.
Type A fuses can be pulled out by the pull–out tool. The location of the pull–out
tool is shown in the illustration.
If you are not sure whether the fuse has blown, try replacing the suspected fuse
with one that you know is good.
If the fuse has blown, push a new fuse into the clip.
Only install a fuse with the amperage rating designated on the fuse box lid.
cccxviii
’99camry CNG
If you do not have a spare fuse, in an emergency you can pull out the
“MIRROR–HEATER”, “DOME” or “A/C” fuse, which may be dispensable for normal
driving, and use it if its amperage rating is the same.
If you cannot use one of the same amperage, use one that is lower,but as close
as possible to, the rating. If the amperage is lower than that specified, the fuse
might blow out again but this does not indicate anything wrong. Be sure to get the
correct fuse as soon as possible and return the substitute to its original clip.
It is a good idea to purchase a set of spare fuses and keep them in your vehicle
for emergencies.
If the new fuse immediately blows out, there is a problem with the electrical system.
Have your authorized Toyota CNG dealer correct it as soon as possible.
CAUTION
Never use a fuse with a higher amperage rating, or any other object, in place
of a fuse. This may cause extensive damage and possibly a fire.
Adding washer fluid
If any washer does not work or low windshield washer fluid level warning light
comes on, the washer tank may be empty. Add washer fluid.
You may use plain water as washer fluid. However, in cold areas where temperatures range below freezing point, use washer fluid containing antifreeze. This product is available at your authorized Toyota CNG dealer and most auto parts stores.
Follow the manufacturer’s directions for how much to mix with water.
cccxix
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or any other substitute because it may damage
your vehicle’s paint.
Replacing light bulbs—
The following illustrations show how to gain access to the bulbs. When replacing
a bulb, make sure the ignition switch and light switch are off. Use bulbs with the
wattage ratings given in the table.
CAUTION
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and require special handling.
They can burst or shatter if scratched or dropped. Hold a bulb only by its
plastic or metal case. Do not touch the glass part of a bulb with bare hands.
NOTICE
Only use a bulb of the listed type.
Light bulbs
Headlights
Parking, front side
marker and front
turn signal lights
Bulb
No.
W
Type
HB2
60/55
A
—
27/8
B
cccxx
’99camry CNG
Rear side marker
lights
194
3.8
C
Rear turn signal
lights
3156
27
C
Stop and tail lights
3157
27/8
C
Tail light
904
9.3
C
Back–up lights
921
18
C
—
5
C
21CP
18
C
Interior light
—
10
D
Glove box light
—
1.2
C
Trunk light
—
3.8
C
License plate lights
High mounted
stoplight
A:
B:
C:
D:
HB2 halogen bulbs
Single end bulbs
Wedge base bulbs
Double end bulbs
—Headlights
cccxxi
’99camry CNG
1. Open the hood. Unplug the connector. Remove the rubber cover.
If the connector is tight, wiggle it.
cccxxii
’99camry CNG
—Parking, front side marker
2.
Release
bulbsignal
retaining
spring and remove the bulb. Install a new bulb
and
fronttheturn
lights
and the bulb retaining spring.
To install a bulb, align the tabs of the bulb with the cutouts of the mounting hole.
3. Install the rubber cover with the “TOP” mark upward, and snuggle on the
boss. Insert the connector. Then install the plastic cover.
Make sure the rubber cover fits snugly on the connector and the headlight body.
Aiming is not necessary after replacing the bulb. When aiming adjustment is necessary, contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer.
cccxxiii
’99camry CNG
Use a flat–bladed screwdriver. Remove and install the cover clips as shown in the
following illustrations.
cccxxiv
’99camry CNG
Removing cover clips
Installing cover clips
cccxxv
’99camry CNG
Use a flat–bladed screw driver. To protect the surface, place several sheets of paper
over the surface.
cccxxvi
’99camry CNG
—Rear side maker, rear turn
signal, stop and tail lights
cccxxvii
’99camry CNG
a: Rear side marker light
b: Rear turn signal light
c: Stop and tail light
—Back–up and tail lights
cccxxviii
’99camry CNG
Use a flat–bladed screwdriver. Remove and install the cover clips as shown in the
following illustrations.
cccxxix
’99camry CNG
Removing the cover clips
Installing the cover clips
cccxxx
’99camry CNG
a: Back–up light
b: Tail light
cccxxxi
’99camry CNG
—License plate lights
Use a flat–bladed screwdriver. Remove and install the cover clips as shown in the
following illustrations.
cccxxxii
’99camry CNG
Removing cover clips
Installing cover clips
cccxxxiii
’99camry CNG
—High mounted stoplight
cccxxxiv
’99camry CNG
cccxxxv
’99camry CNG
cccxxxvi
’99camry CNG
cccxxxvii
’99camry CNG
Part 2
INFORMATION
BEFORE DRIVING
YOUR TOYOTA
Break–in period
Fuel
Fuel system
Operation in foreign countries
Three–way catalytic converter
Engine exhaust cautions
Facts about engine oil
consumption
Twin ground electrode
platinum–tipped spark plugs
Brake system
Brake pad wear limit indicators
Luggage stowage precautions
Your Toyota’s identification
Theft prevention labels
Suspension and chassis
clxxxvii
’99camry CNG
Types of tires
Break–in period
Drive gently and avoid high speeds.
Your vehicle does not need an elaborate break–in. But following a few simple tips
for the first 1600 km (1000 miles) can add to the future economy and long life of
your vehicle:
Do not drive over 88 km/h (55 mph).
Run the engine at moderate speed between 2000 and 4000 rpm.
Avoid full–throttle starts.
Try to avoid hard stops during the first 300 km (200 miles).
Do not drive slowly with the manual transmission in a high gear.
Do not drive for a long time at any single speed, either fast or slow.
Do not tow a trailer during the first 800 km (500 miles).
Fuel
Fuel used for your vehicle is compressed natural gas (CNG). The main ingredient
of the natural gas is flammable, colorless methane, which generates lower emissions
compared with a gasoline–engine vehicle. The natural gas you use for refueling
must meet NFPA–52 and SAE–J1616 standards.
If you smell natural gas or hear the sound of leaking fuel while refueling, stop
refueling immediately. If you smell or hear fuel leaking other than when refueling,
shut off the fuel system. (See “If you suspect the fuel is leaking” in Part 4.)
clxxxviii
’99camry CNG
Fuel system—
—Components
CAUTION
Natural gas is flammable and explosive. Take due care to keep away from
fire and sparks at all times.
If you suspect the fuel is leaking while refueling, stop refueling immediately. If leaking fuel is ignited, an explosion or fire could occur, causing death
or serious injury.
If you smell or hear natural gas leaking, shut off the fuel system immediately. If leaking fuel is ignited, an explosion or fire could occur, causing
death or serious injury.
NOTICE
Do not use improper fuel that does not meet the required standards. Using
improper fuel may affect the engine performance or cause damage to the
emission control system.
If you suspect any abnormality in the fuel system, have your vehicle
inspected by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as possible.
clxxxix
’99camry CNG
1. Fuel tank
2. Manual shut off valve
Have the fuel system checked and maintained by your authorized Toyota CNG
dealer.
—Fuel tank
The fuel tank on your vehicle conforms to ANSI/AGA NGV–2, NFPA–52 and DOT
NHTSA FMVSS 304 safety standards.
Removal, servicing, discharge of fuel and disposal of the tank should only be
done by a qualified technician as prescribed by the fuel control regulation of
NFPA–52, and all applicable federal, state and local regulations.
Have the fuel tank inspected at the interval listed in the “Scheduled
Maintenance Guide”. The fuel tank also requires inspection if the vehicle is
involved in a collision or fire hazard.
Warning labels on the fuel tank and the engine compartment indicate the
service limit date of the tank. Do not remove or paint over the labels.
cxc
’99camry CNG
See instructions on fuel container for inspection and
service life.
CAUTION
This tank contains high pressure flammable natural gas. You must ensure
that the tank is checked and inspected and properly maintained, as well
as avoid overfilling or drilling holes in it, or damaging it in any other way
because death or serious injury may result.
Do not allow any person other than a qualified technician to remove this
tank from the vehicle. If residual gas in the tank is not discharged correctly, static electricity may be ignited, causing fire or explosion.
Do not leave the fuel tank where the temperature can exceed 80C (176F).
The tank’s built–in pressure relief device may open and release all the fuel
from under the floor.
NOTICE
Do not damage the tank. If the tank is damaged, have it inspected by your
authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as possible.
Do not expose the tank to chlorine, oxygen or other corrosive liquids.
This tank is intended for use with compressed natural gas—the fuel for
this vehicle. Do not use it for any other purpose.
cxci
’99camry CNG
SERVICE PRESSURE:
24800 kPa (3600 psig)
Equivalent gasoline capacity:
43 L (11.4 gal., 9.5 lmp.gal.)
Water volume:
135 L (35.7 gal., 29.7 lmp.gal.)
—Fuel shut off system
If the engine stalls, fuel flow from the tank is automatically shut off. When restarting
the engine after fuel flow is shut off, turn the ignition switch to “ACC” or “LOCK”
once and then start it. The fuel flow from the tank will also be shut off automatically
when an airbag inflates upon collision or if the piping is disconnected.
CAUTION
If the vehicle is involved in a collision and there is a chance that there may
be fuel leakage, never restart the engine. Ignition of leaked natural gas may
cause death or serious injury.
Manual shut off valve
This valve is for manually shutting off fuel from the tank. It is usually left
open. Use this valve to shut off fuel if you suspect that the fuel is leaking
or after you have been involved in a collision.
Refer to “If you suspect the fuel is leaking” in Part 4 for how to operate the valve.
Operation in foreign countries
If you plan to drive your Toyota in another country...
First, comply with the vehicle registration laws.
cxcii
’99camry CNG
Second, confirm the availability of the correct fuel and filling nozzles.
Three–way catalytic converter
The three–way catalytic converter is an emission control device installed in the
exhaust system.
The purpose is to reduce pollutants in the exhaust gas.
CAUTION
Keep people and combustible materials away from the exhaust pipe while
the engine is running. The exhaust gas is very hot.
Do not drive, idle or park your vehicle over anything that might burn easily
such as grass, leaves, paper or rags.
cxciii
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
A large amount of unburned gases flowing into the three–way catalytic
converter may cause it to overheat and create a fire hazard. To prevent this
and other damage, observe the following precautions:
Use only CNG (Compressed Natural Gas).
Do not drive with an extremely low fuel level; running out of fuel could
cause the engine to misfire, creating an excessive load on the three–way
catalytic converter.
Do not allow the engine to run at idle speed for more than 20 minutes.
Avoid racing the engine.
Do not push–start or pull–start your vehicle.
Do not turn off the ignition while the vehicle is moving.
cxciv
’99camry CNG
Keep your engine in good running order. Malfunctions in the engine electrical system, electronic ignition system/distributor ignition system or fuel
system could cause an extremely high three–way catalytic converter temperature.
If the engine becomes difficult to start or stalls frequently, take your
vehicle in for a check–up as soon as possible. Remember, your authorized
Toyota CNG dealer knows your vehicle and its three–way catalytic converter system best.
To ensure that the three–way catalytic converter and the entire emission
control system operate properly, your vehicle must receive the periodic
inspections required by the Toyota Maintenance Schedule. For scheduled
maintenance information, refer to the separate “Owner’s Manual Supplement”.
Engine exhaust cautions
cxcv
’99camry CNG
Facts about engine oil
consumption
CAUTION
Avoid inhaling the engine exhaust. It contains carbon monoxide, which is
a colorless and odorless gas. It can cause unconsciousness or even death.
Make sure the exhaust system has no holes or loose connections. The
system should be checked from time to time. If you hit something, or
notice a change in the sound of the exhaust, have the system checked
immediately.
Do not run the engine in a garage or enclosed area except for the time
needed to drive the vehicle in or out. The exhaust gases cannot escape,
making this a particularly dangerous situation.
Do not remain for a long time in a parked vehicle with the engine running.
If it is unavoidable, however, do so only in an unconfined area and adjust
the heating or cooling system to force outside air into the vehicle.
Keep the trunk lid closed while driving. An open or unsealed trunk lid may
cause exhaust gases to be drawn into the vehicle.
To allow proper operation of your vehicle’s ventilation system, keep the
inlet grilles in front of the windshield clear of snow, leaves, or other
obstructions.
If you smell exhaust fumes in the vehicle, drive with the windows open
and the trunk lid closed. Have the cause immediately located and corrected.
FUNCTIONS OF ENGINE OIL
cxcvi
’99camry CNG
Engine oil has the primary functions of lubricating and cooling the inside of the
engine, and plays a major role in maintaining the engine in proper working order.
ENGINE OIL CONSUMPTION
It is normal that an engine should consume some engine oil during normal
engine operation. The causes of oil consumption in a normal engine are as
follows.
Oil is used to lubricate pistons, piston rings and cylinders. A thin film of oil is
left on the cylinder wall when a piston moves downwards in the cylinder. High
negative pressure generated when the vehicle is decelerating sucks some of this
oil into the combustion chamber. This oil as well as some part of the oil film
left on the cylinder wall is burned by the high temperature combustion gases
during the combustion process.
Oil is also used to lubricate the stems of the intake valves. Some of this oil
is sucked into the combustion chamber together with the intake air and is burned
along with the fuel. High temperature exhaust gases also burn the oil used to
lubricate the exhaust valve stems.
The amount of engine oil consumed depends on the viscosity of the oil, the
quality of the oil and the conditions the vehicle is driven under.
More oil is consumed by high–speed driving and frequent acceleration and deceleration.
A new engine consumes more oil, since its pistons, piston rings and cylinder walls
have not become conditioned.
When judging the amount of oil consumption, note that the oil may become
diluted and make it difficult to judge the true level accurately.
As an example, if a vehicle is used for repeated short trips, and consumes a
normal amount of oil, the dipstick may not show any drop in the oil level at all,
even after 1000 km (600 miles) or more. This is because the oil is gradually
cxcvii
’99camry CNG
Twin ground electrode
becoming
diluted with fuel
or moisture,
platinum–tipped
spark
plugs making it appear that the oil level has not
changed.
The diluting ingredients evaporate out when the vehicle is then driven at high
speeds, as on an express way, making it appear that oil is excessively consumed
after driving at high speeds.
IMPORTANCE OF ENGINE OIL LEVEL CHECK
One of the most important points in proper vehicle maintenance is to keep the
engine oil at the optimum level so that oil function will not be impaired. Therefore,
it is essential that the oil level be checked regularly. Toyota recommends that the
oil level be checked every time you refuel the vehicle.
NOTICE
Failure to check the oil level regularly could lead to serious engine trouble
due to insufficient oil.
For detailed information on oil level check, see “Checking the engine oil level” in
Chapter 7–2.
cxcviii
’99camry CNG
Your engine is fitted with twin ground electrode platinum–tipped spark plugs.
NOTICE
For your engine performance, use only twin ground electrode platinum–tipped
spark plugs specially designed for CNG vehicles. Spark plugs for gasoline–
engined vehicles cannot be used for your vehicle.
Brake system
TANDEM MASTER CYLINDER BRAKE SYSTEM
The tandem master cylinder brake system is a hydraulic system with two separate
sub–systems. If either sub–system should fail, the other will still work. However, the
pedal will be harder to press, and your stopping distance will be longer. Also, the
brake system warning light may come on.
cxcix
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not drive your vehicle with only a single brake system. Have your brakes
fixed immediately.
BRAKE BOOSTER
The brake booster uses engine vacuum to power–assist the brakes. If the engine
should quit while you are driving, you can bring the vehicle to a stop with normal
pedal pressure. There is enough reserved vacuum for one or two stops—but no
more!
CAUTION
Do not pump the brake pedal if the engine stalls. Each push on the pedal
uses up your reserved vacuum.
Even if the power assist is completely lost, the brakes will still work. But
you will have to push the pedal hard—much harder than normal. And your
braking distance will be longer.
ANTI–LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
The anti–lock brake system is designed to automatically help prevent lock–up of the
wheels during sudden braking or braking on slippery road surfaces. This assists in
providing directional stability and steering performance of the vehicle under these
circumstances.
The anti–lock brake system becomes operative after the vehicle has accelerated to
a speed in excess of approximately 10 km/h (6 mph). It stops operating when the
vehicle decelerate to a speed below approximately 5 km/h (3 mph).
cc
’99camry CNG
You may hear a sound in the engine compartment for a few seconds when the
engine is started or just after the vehicle is started. This means that the anti–lock
brake system is in the self check mode, and does not indicate a malfunction.
Effective way to press the “ABS” brake pedal: When the anti–lock brake system
function is in action, you may feel the brake pedal pulsating and hear a noise.
In this situation, to let the anti–lock brake system work for you, just hold the
brake pedal down more firmly. Do not pump the brake in a panic stop. Pumping
the brake pedal makes the stopping distance longer.
The brake pedal pulsation caused by the anti–lock brake system may indicate
hazardous road surface conditions. Although the anti–lock brake system assists in
providing vehicle control, it is still important to drive with all due care, because the
anti–lock brake system cannot overcome the laws of physics that act on your
vehicle:
Braking capability is dependent on tire friction with the road surface.
Even though the anti–lock brake system is operating, a driver cannot maintain
full control on certain slippery road surfaces, when cornering at high speeds, or
in violent maneuvers.
Avoid high speeds on wet roads. The anti–lock brake system cannot eliminate
the risk of hydroplaning and loss of tire friction.
Always maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front of you. Compared with
vehicles not fitted with an anti–lock brake system, your vehicle may require a longer
stopping distance in the following cases:
Driving on rough, gravel or snow–covered roads.
Driving with tire chains installed.
cci
’99camry CNG
Driving on roads where the road surface is pitted or has other differences in
surface height.
“ABS” warning light
The light comes on when the ignition key is turned to the “ON” position. After a
few seconds, the light will go off.
If either of the following conditions occurs, this indicates a malfunction somewhere
in the parts monitored by the warning light system. Contact your authorized Toyota
CNG dealer as soon as possible to service the vehicle.
The light does not come on as described above, or remains on.
The light comes on while driving.
Even if the anti–lock brake system should fail, the brake system will still operate
conventionally. However, when the “ABS” warning light is on (and the brake system
warning light is off), the anti–lock brake system is not assisting brake performance
ccii
’99camry CNG
so that the wheels can lock–up during sudden braking or braking on slippery road
surfaces. Have your vehicle checked by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon
as possible.
Brake pad wear limit indicators
The brake pad wear limit indicators on your disc brakes give a warning noise
when the brake pads are worn to where replacement is required.
If you hear a squealing or scraping noise while driving, have the brake pads
checked and replaced by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as possible.
Expensive rotor damage can result if the pads are not replaced when necessary.
Luggage stowage precautions
When stowing luggage or cargo in the vehicle, observe the following:
Put luggage or cargo in the trunk when at all possible. Be sure all items are
secured in place.
Be careful to keep the vehicle balanced. Locating the weight as far forward as
possible helps maintain balance.
cciii
’99camry CNG
Your Toyota’s identification—
For better
fuel economy, do not carry unneeded weight.
—CNG
identification
CAUTION
Do not place anything on the filler panel behind the rear seatback. Such
items may be thrown about and possibly injure people in the vehicle
during sudden braking or an accident.
Do not drive with objects left on top of the instrument panel. They may
interfere with the driver’s field of view. Or they may move during sharp
vehicle acceleration or turning, and impair the driver’s control of the
vehicle. In an accident they may injure the vehicle occupants.
NOTICE
Ensure that all luggage placed in the trunk is secure. Extra care should
be taken with heavy items and items with protrusions as they may get
beyond the partition to the tank and damage the tank or fuel system
components.
Do not load the vehicle beyond the vehicle capacity weight specified in
Part 8.
cciv
’99camry CNG
—Vehicle identification
number
A special label is pasted close to the license plate on a CNG vehicle. Do not
remove this label.
ccv
’99camry CNG
The vehicle identification number (VIN) is the legal identifier for your vehicle.
This number is on the left top of the instrument panel, and can be seen
through the windshield from outside.
This is the primary identification number for your Toyota. It is used in registering
the ownership of your vehicle.
The vehicle identification number (VIN) is also on the Certification Label.
—Engine number
ccvi
’99camry CNG
The engine number is stamped on the engine block as shown.
Theft prevention labels
Your new vehicle carries theft prevention labels which are approximately 56
mm (2.20 in.) by 16 mm (0.63 in.).
The purpose of these labels is to reduce the incidence of vehicle thefts by facilitating the tracing and recovery of parts from stolen vehicles. The label is designed
so that once it is applied to a surface, any attempt to remove it will result in
destroying the integrity of the label. Transferring these labels intact from one part
to another, will be impossible.
NOTICE
You should not attempt to remove the theft prevention labels as it may
violate certain state or federal laws.
Suspension and chassis
ccvii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not modify the suspension/chassis with lift kits, spacers, springs, etc. It
can cause dangerous vehicle handling characteristics, resulting in loss of
control.
Types of tires
Determine what kind of tires your vehicle is originally equipped with.
1. Summer tires
Summer tires are high–speed capability tires best suited to highway driving under
dry conditions.
Since summer tires do not have the same traction performance as snow tires,
summer tires are inadequate for driving on snow–covered or icy roads. For driving
on snow–covered or icy roads, we recommend using snow tires. If installing snow
tires, be sure to replace all four tires.
2. All season tires
All season tires are designed to provide better traction in snow and to be adequate
for driving in most winter conditions, as well as for use all year round.
All season tires, however, do not have adequate traction performance compared with
snow tires in heavy or loose snow. Also, all season tires fall short in acceleration
and handling performance compared with summer tires in highway driving.
ccviii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not mix summer and all season tires on your vehicle as this can cause
dangerous handling characteristics, resulting in loss of control.
Do not use tires other than the manufacturer’s designated tires, and never
mix tires or wheels of the sizes different from the originally equipped tires
and wheels.
ccix
’99camry CNG
ccx
’99camry CNG
How to start the engine—
(a) Before
Part
3 cranking
STARTING AND
DRIVING
Before starting the engine
How to start the engine
Tips for driving in various
conditions
Winter driving tips
Trailer towing
How to save fuel and make
your vehicle last longer, too
Before starting the engine
1. Check the area around the vehicle before entering it.
2. Adjust seat position, seatback angle, head restraint height and steering wheel
angle.
3. Adjust inside and outside rear view mirrors.
4. Lock all doors.
5. Fasten seat belts.
1. Apply the parking brake firmly.
2. Turn off unnecessary lights and accessories.
ccxi
’99camry CNG
3. Put the selector lever in “P”. If you need to restart the engine while the vehicle
is moving, put the selector lever in “N”. A starter safety device will prevent the
starter from operating if the selector lever is in any drive position.
4. Depress the brake pedal and hold it to the floor until driving off.
(b) Starting the engine
Before starting the engine, be sure to follow the instructions in “(a) Before cranking”.
Normal starting procedure
The multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system in your
engine automatically controls the proper air–fuel mixture for starting. You can start
a cold or hot engine as follows:
1. With your foot off the accelerator pedal, turn the key to “ON” and hold it there
for a few seconds so that the fuel flows to the engine. Then crank the engine
by turning the key to “START”. Release it when the engine starts.
You will hear a click noise coming from the fuel tank, but this is normal.
2. After the engine runs for about 10 seconds, you are ready to drive.
If the weather is below freezing, let the engine warm up for a few minutes before
driving.
If the engine stalls...
Simply restart it, using the correct procedure given in normal starting.
If the engine will not start...
See “If your vehicle will not start” in Part 4.
ccxii
’99camry CNG
Tips for driving in various
conditions
NOTICE
Do not crank for more than 30 seconds at a time. This may overheat the
starter and wiring systems.
Do not race a cold engine.
If the engine becomes difficult to start or stalls frequently, have the engine
checked immediately.
Always slow down in gusty crosswinds. This will allow you much better control.
Drive slowly onto curbs and, if possible, at a right angle. Avoid driving onto high,
sharp–edged objects and other road hazards. Failure to do so can lead to severe
tire damage resulting in tire bursts.
When parking on a hill, turn the front wheels until they touch the curb so that
the vehicle will not roll. Apply the parking brake, and place the transmission in
“P”. If necessary, block the wheels.
Washing your vehicle or driving through deep water may get the brakes wet. To
see whether they are wet, check that there is no traffic near you, and then press
the pedal lightly. If you do not feel a normal braking force, the brakes are
probably wet. To dry them, drive the vehicle cautiously while lightly pressing the
brake pedal with the parking brake applied. If they still do not work safely, pull
to the side of the road and call your authorized Toyota CNG dealer for assistance.
ccxiii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Before driving off, make sure that the parking brake is fully released and
the parking brake reminder light is off.
Do not leave your vehicle unattended while the engine is running.
Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while driving. It can cause
dangerous overheating, needless wear, and poor fuel economy.
To drive down a long or steep hill, reduce your speed and downshift.
Remember, if you ride the brakes excessively, they may overheat and not
work properly.
Be careful when accelerating, upshifting, downshifting or braking on a
slippery surface. Sudden acceleration or engine braking could cause the
vehicle to spin or skid.
Do not drive in excess of the speed limit. Even if the legal speed limit
permits it, do not drive over 140 km/h (85 mph) unless your vehicle has
high–speed capability tires. Driving over 140 km/h (85 mph) may result in
tire failure, loss of control and possible injury. Be sure to consult a tire
dealer to determine whether the tires on your vehicle are high–speed
capability tires or not before driving at such speeds.
Do not continue normal driving when the brakes are wet. If they are wet,
your vehicle will require a longer stopping distance, and it may pull to one
side when the brakes are applied. Also, the parking brake will not hold the
vehicle securely.
Winter driving tips
ccxiv
’99camry CNG
Make sure you have a proper freeze protection of engine coolant.
Your coolant must contain ethylene–glycol type coolant for a proper corrosion
protection of aluminum components. Use “TOYOTA Long Life Coolant” or equivalent.
See Chapter 7–2 for details about coolant type selection.
NOTICE
Do not use alcohol type antifreeze or plain water alone.
When it is extremely cold, we recommend to use 60% solution for your Toyota, to
provide protection down to about –50°C (–58°F). Do not use more than 70% solution
for better coolant performance.
Check the condition of the battery and cables.
Cold temperatures reduce the capacity of any battery, so it must be in top shape
to provide enough power for winter starting. Chapter 7–3 tells you how to visually
inspect the battery. Your authorized Toyota CNG dealer and most service stations
will be pleased to check the level of charge.
Make sure the engine oil viscosity is suitable for the cold weather.
See Chapter 7–2 for recommended viscosity. Leaving a heavy summer oil in your
vehicle during winter months may cause harder starting. If you are not sure about
which oil to use, call your authorized Toyota CNG dealer—he will be pleased to
help.
Keep the door locks from freezing.
Squirt lock de–icer or glycerine into the locks to keep them from freezing. To open
a frozen look, try heating the key before inserting it.
Use a washer fluid containing an antifreeze solution.
ccxv
’99camry CNG
This product is available at your authorized Toyota CNG dealer and most auto parts
stores. Follow the manufacturer’s directions for how much to mix with water.
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or any other substitute because it may damage
your vehicle’s paint.
Do not use your parking brake when there is a possibility it could freeze.
When parking, put the transmission into “P” and block the rear wheels. Do not use
the parking brake, or snow or water accumulated in and around the parking brake
mechanism may freeze, making it hard to release.
Keep ice and snow from accumulating under the fenders.
Ice and snow built up under your fenders can make steering difficult. During bad
winter driving, stop and check under the fenders occasionally.
Depending on where you are driving, we recommend you carry some emergency equipment.
Some of the things you might put in the vehicle are tire chains, window scraper,
bag of sand or salt, flares, small shovel, jumper cables, etc.
Trailer towing
Your vehicle is designed primarily as a passenger–carrying vehicle. Towing a trailer
will have an adverse effect on handling, performance, braking, durability and driving
economy (fuel consumption, etc.). Your safety and satisfaction depend on the proper
use of correct equipment and cautious driving habits. For your safety and the safety
of others, you must not overload your vehicle or trailer. Toyota warranties do not
apply to damage or malfunction caused by towing a trailer for commercial purposes.
Ask your authorized Toyota CNG dealer for further details before towing.
WEIGHT LIMITS
ccxvi
’99camry CNG
Before towing, make sure the total trailer weight, gross vehicle weight, gross axle
weight and trailer tongue load are all within the limits.
The total trailer weight and tongue load can be measured with platform scales found
at a highway weighing station, building supply company, trucking company, junk
yard, etc.
CAUTION
The total trailer weight (trailer weight plus its cargo load) must not exceed
907 kg (2000 lb.). Exceeding this weight is dangerous.
ccxvii
’99camry CNG
Trailer hitch assemblies have different weight capacities established by the
hitch manufacturer. Even though the vehicle may be physically capable of
towing a higher weight, the operator must determine the maximum weight
rating of the particular hitch assembly and never exceed the maximum
weight rating specified for the trailer–hitch. Exceeding the maximum weight
rating set by the trailer hitch manufacturer can cause an accident resulting
in serious personal injuries.
The gross vehicle weight must not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) indicated on the Certification Label. The gross vehicle weight is
the sum of weights of the unloaded vehicle, driver, passengers, luggage,
hitch and trailer tongue load. It also includes the weight of any special
equipment installed on your vehicle.
The load on either the front or rear axle resulting from distribution of the
gross vehicle weight on both axles must not exceed the Gross Axle Weight
Rating (GAWR) listed on the Certification Label.
ccxviii
’99camry CNG
Total trailer weight
Tongue load
Total trailer weight
Tongue load
100 = 9 to 11%
The trailer cargo load should be distributed so that the tongue load is 9
to 11% of the total trailer weight, not exceeding the maximum of 90 kg
(200 lb.). Never load the trailer with more weight in the back than in the
front. About 60% of the trailer load should be in the front half of the
trailer and the remaining 40% in the rear.
HITCHES
Use only a hitch which is recommended by the hitch manufacturer and conforms
to the total trailer weight requirement.
Follow the directions supplied by the hitch manufacturer. Lubricate the hitch ball
with a light coat of grease.
Toyota recommends removing the trailer hitch whenever you are not towing a
trailer to reduce the possibility of additional damage caused by the hitch if your
vehicle is struck from behind.
ccxix
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Do not use axle–mounted hitches as they can cause damage to the axle
housing, wheel bearings, wheels or tires. Also, never install a hitch which
may interfere with the normal function of an Energy Absorbing Bumper, if
so equipped.
BRAKES AND SAFETY CHAINS
Toyota recommends trailers with brakes that conform to any applicable
federal and state/provincial regulations.
A safety chain must always be used between the towing vehicle and the
trailer. Leave sufficient slack in the chain for turns. The chain should cross
under the trailer tongue to prevent the tongue from dropping to the ground
in case it becomes damaged or separated. For correct safety chain procedures, follow the hitch or trailer manufacturer’s recommendations.
CAUTION
If the total trailer weight exceeds 453 kg (1000 lb.), trailer brakes are
required.
Never tap into your vehicle’s hydraulic system as it would lower its braking effectiveness.
Never tow a trailer without using a safety chain securely attached to both
the trailer and the vehicle. If damage occurs to the coupling unit or hitch
ball, there is danger of the trailer wandering over into another lane.
TIRES
ccxx
’99camry CNG
Ensure that your vehicle’s tires are properly inflated. Adjust the tire pressure to
the recommended cold tire pressure indicated below (See Chapter 7–2 for
instructions.):
Tire pressure, kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi)
220 (2.2, 32)
The trailer tires should be inflated to the pressure recommended by the trailer
manufacturer in respect to the total trailer weight.
TRAILER LIGHTS
Trailer lights must comply with federal, state/provincial and local regulations. See
your local recreational vehicle dealer or rental agency for the correct type of
wiring and relays for your trailer. Check for correct operation of the turn signals
and stop lights each time you hitch up. Direct splicing may damage your vehicle’s electrical system and cause a malfunction of your lights.
BREAK–IN SCHEDULE
Toyota recommends that you do not tow a trailer with a new vehicle or a vehicle
with any new power train component (engine, transmission, differential, wheel
bearing, etc.) for the first 800 km (500 miles) of driving.
MAINTENANCE
If you tow a trailer, your vehicle will require more frequent maintenance due to
the additional load. For this information, please refer to
maintenance information in the “Owner’s Manual Supplement”.
the
scheduled
Retighten all fixing bolts of the towing ball and bracket after approximately 1000
km (600 miles) of trailer driving.
PRE–TOWING SAFETY CHECK
ccxxi
’99camry CNG
Check that your vehicle remains level when a loaded or unloaded trailer is
hitched. Do not drive if the vehicle has an abnormal nose–up or nose–down
condition, and check for improper tongue load, overload,worn suspension or other
possible causes.
Make sure the trailer cargo is securely loaded so that it can not shift.
Check that your rear view mirrors conform to any applicable federal, state/provincial or local regulation. If not, install the rear view mirrors required for towing
purpose.
TRAILER TOWING TIPS
When towing a trailer, your vehicle will handle differently than when not
towing. The three main causes of vehicle–trailer accidents are driver error,
excessive speed and improper trailer loading. Keep these in mind when towing:
Before starting out, check operation of the lights and all vehicle–trailer connections. After driving a short distance, stop and recheck the lights and connections.
Before actually towing a trailer, practice turning, stopping and backing with a
trailer in an area away from traffic until you learn the feel.
Backing with a trailer is difficult and requires practice. Grip the bottom of the
steering wheel and move your hand to the left to move the trailer to the left.
Move your hand to the right to move the trailer to the right. (This procedure is
generally opposite to that when backing without a trailer). Also, just turn the
steering wheel a little at a time, avoiding sharp or prolonged turning. Have
someone guide you when backing to reduce the risk of an accident.
Because stopping distance may be increased, vehicle–to–vehicle distance should
be increased when towing a trailer. For each 16 km/h (10 mph) of speed, allow
at least one vehicle and trailer length between you and the vehicle ahead. Avoid
sudden braking as you may skid, resulting in jackknifing and loss of control. This
is especially true on wet or slippery surfaces.
ccxxii
’99camry CNG
Avoid jerky starts or sudden acceleration. If your vehicle has a manual transmission, prevent excessive clutch slippage by keeping engine rpm low and not
racing the engine. Always start out in first gear.
Avoid jerky steering and sharp turns. The trailer could hit your vehicle in a tight
turn. Slow down before making a turn to avoid the necessity of sudden braking.
Remember that when making a turn, the trailer wheels will be closer than the
vehicle wheels to the inside of the turn. Therefore, compensate for this by
making a larger than normal turning radius with your vehicle.
Crosswinds and rough roads will adversely affect handling of your vehicle and
trailer, causing sway. Pay attention to the rear from time to time to prepare
yourself for being passed by large trucks or buses, which may cause your
vehicle and trailer to sway. If swaying happens, firmly grip the steering wheel
and reduce speed immediately but gradually. Never increase speed. Steer straight
ahead. If you make no extreme correction with the steering or brakes, the
vehicle and trailer will stabilize.
Be careful when passing other vehicles. Passing requires considerable distance.
After passing a vehicle, do not forget the length of your trailer and be sure you
have plenty of room before changing lanes.
In order to maintain engine braking efficiency do not use overdrive.
Because of the added load of the trailer, your vehicle’s engine may overheat on
hot days (at temperatures over 30C [85F]) when going up a long or steep
grade with a trailer. If the engine coolant temperature gauge indicates overheating, immediately turn off the air conditioning (if in use), pull off the road and
stop in a safe spot. Refer to “If your vehicle overheats” in Part 4 of this manual.
ccxxiii
’99camry CNG
Always place wheel blocks under both the vehicle and trailer wheels when
parking. Apply the parking brake firmly. Put the transmission in “P”. Avoid
parking on a slope with a trailer, but if it cannot be avoided, do so only after
performing the following:
1. Apply the brakes and hold.
2. Have someone place wheel blocks under both the vehicle and trailer wheels.
3. When the wheel blocks are in place, release your brakes slowly until the blocks
absorb the load.
4. Apply the parking brake firmly.
5. Shift into “P” and turn off the engine.
When restarting out after parking on a slope:
1. With the transmission in “P” position, start the engine. (Be sure to keep the
brake pedal depressed.)
2. Shift into gear.
3. Release the parking brake (also foot brake on automatic transmission vehicles)
and slowly pull or back away from the wheel blocks. Stop and apply your brakes.
4. Have someone retrieve the blocks.
ccxxiv
’99camry CNG
How to save fuel and make
your vehicle last longer, too
CAUTION
Do not exceed 72 km/h (45 mph) or the posted towing speed limit,whichever is lower. Because instability (swaying) of a towing vehicle–trailer combination usually increases as the speed increases,exceeding 72 km/h (45
mph) may cause loss of control.
Slow down and downshift before descending steep or long downhill
grades. Do not make sudden downshifts.
Avoid holding the brake pedal down too long or too frequently. This could
cause the brakes to overheat and result in reduced braking efficiency.
Getting more kilometers/mileage from a liter/gallon of fuel is easy—just take it easy.
It will help make your vehicle last longer, too. Here are some specific tips on how
to save money on both fuel and repairs:
Keep your tires inflated at the correct pressure. Underinflation causes tire
wear and wastes fuel. See Chapter 7–2 for instructions.
Do not carry unneeded weight in your vehicle. Excess weight puts a heavier
load on the engine, causing greater fuel consumption.
Avoid lengthy warm–up idling. Once the engine is running smoothly, begin
driving—but gently. Remember, however, that on cold winter days this may take
a little longer.
Accelerate slowly and smoothly. Avoid jackrabbit starts. Get into high gear as
quickly as possible.
Avoid long engine idling. If you have a long wait and you are not in traffic,
it is better to turn off the engine and start again later.
ccxxv
’99camry CNG
Avoid engine lug or overrevving. Use a gear position suitable for the road on
which you are travelling.
Avoid continuous speeding up and slowing down. Stop–and–go driving wastes
fuel.
Avoid unnecessary stopping and braking. Maintain a steady pace. Try to time
the traffic signals so you only need to stop as little as possible or take advantage of through streets to avoid traffic lights. Keep a proper distance from other
vehicles to avoid sudden braking. This will also reduce wear on your brakes.
Avoid heavy traffic or traffic jams whenever possible.
Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal. This causes needless wear, overheating and poor fuel economy.
Maintain a moderate speed on highways. The faster you drive,the greater the
fuel consumption. By reducing your speed, you will cut down on fuel consumption.
Keep the front wheels in proper alignment. Avoid hitting the curb and slow
down on rough roads. Improper alignment not only causes faster tire wear but
also puts an extra load on the engine, which, in turn, wastes fuel.
Keep the bottom of your vehicle free from mud, etc. This not only lessens
weight but also helps prevent corrosion.
Keep your vehicle tuned–up and in top shape. A dirty air cleaner, improper
valve clearance, dirty plugs, dirty oil and grease,brakes not adjusted, etc. all
lower engine performance and contribute to poor fuel economy. For longer life of
all parts and lower operating costs, keep all maintenance work on schedule, and
if you often drive under severe conditions, see that your vehicle receives more
frequent maintenance (For scheduled maintenance information, please refer to the
separate “Owner’s Manual Supplement”.
ccxxvi
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Never turn off the engine to coast down hills. Your power steering and brake
booster will not function without the engine running. Also, the emission
control system operates properly only when the engine is running.
ccxxvii
’99camry CNG
If your vehicle will not start—
(a) Simple
Part
4 checks
IN CASE OF AN
EMERGENCY
If your vehicle will not start
If your engine stalls while
driving
If your vehicle overheats
If you have a flat tire
If your vehicle needs to be
towed
If you cannot shift automatic
transmission selector lever
If you lose your keys
If you suspect the fuel is leaking
Before making these checks, make sure you have followed the correct starting
procedure given in “How to start the engine” in Part 3 and that you have sufficient
fuel.
If the engine is not turning over or is turning over too slowly—
1. Check that the battery terminals are tight and clean.
2. If the battery terminals are O.K., switch on the interior light.
ccxxviii
’99camry CNG
3. If the light is out, dim or goes out when the starter is cranked, the battery is
discharged. You may try jump starting. See “(c) Jump starting” for further instructions.
If the light is O.K., but the engine still will not start, it needs adjustment or repair.
Call your authorized Toyota CNG dealer or a qualified repair shop.
NOTICE
Do not pull– or push–start the vehicle. It may damage the vehicle or cause
a collision when the engine starts. Also the three–way catalytic converter
may overheat and become a fire hazard.
If the engine turns over at its normal speed but will not start—
1. Check that all the push–on connectors are tight. (For example, connectors at the
spark plugs, ignition coil and/or distributor)
2. If the connectors are O.K., the engine may be flooded because of repeated
cranking. See “(b) Starting a flooded engine” for further instructions.
3. If the engine still does not start, manual shut–off valve may be closed. Open
the manual shut–off valve. (See “If you suspect the fuel is leaking” in this
chapter.)
(b) Starting a flooded engine
If the engine will not start, your engine may be flooded because of repeated
cranking.
If this happens, turn the key to “START” with the accelerator pedal held down. Keep
the key and accelerator pedal so for 15 seconds and release them. Then try
starting the engine with your foot off the accelerator pedal.
If the engine does not start after 30 seconds of cranking, release the key, wait a
few minutes and try again.
ccxxix
’99camry CNG
If the engine still will not start, it needs adjustment or repair. Call your authorized
Toyota CNG dealer or a qualified repair shop for assistance.
NOTICE
Do not crank for more than 30 seconds at a time. This may overheat the
starter and wiring systems.
(c) Jump starting
To avoid serious personal injury and damage to your vehicle which might
result from battery explosion, acid burns, electrical burns, or damaged electronic components, these instructions must be followed precisely.
If you are unsure about how to follow this procedure, we strongly recommend that
you seek the help of a competent mechanic or towing service.
CAUTION
Batteries contain sulfuric acid which is poisonous and corrosive. Wear
protective safety glasses when jump starting, and avoid spilling acid on
your skin, clothing, or vehicle.
If you should accidentally get acid on yourself or in your eyes, remove any
contaminated clothing and flush the affected area with water immediately.
Then get immediate medical attention. If possible, continue to apply water
with a sponge or cloth while enroute to the medical office.
The gas normally produced by a battery will explode if a flame or spark
is brought near. Use only standardised jumper cables and do not smoke
or light a match while jump starting.
ccxxx
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
The battery used for boosting must be 12 V. Do not jump start unless you
are sure that the booster battery is correct.
JUMP STARTING PROCEDURE
1. If the booster battery is installed in another vehicle, make sure the vehicles are
not touching. Turn off all unnecessary lights and accessories.
2. If required, remove all the vent plugs from the booster and discharged batteries.
Lay a cloth over the open vents on the batteries. (This helps reduce the
explosion hazard, personal injuries and burns.)
3. If the engine in the vehicle with the booster battery is not running, start it and
let it run for a few minutes. During jump starting run the engine at about 2000
rpm with the accelerator pedal lightly depressed.
Discharged
battery
Booster
battery
Positive
Jumper
terminal
(“+” mark) cable
Positive terminal
(“+” mark)
ccxxxi
’99camry CNG
4. Make the cable connections in the order a, b, c, d.
a. Connect the clamp of the positive (red) jumper cable to the positive ( )
terminal on the discharged battery.
b. Connect the clamp at the other end of the positive (red) jumper cable to the
positive ( ) terminal on the booster battery.
Jumper cable
Discharged
battery
Negative
terminal (“–” mark)
Booster
battery
c. Connect the clamp of the negative (black) jumper cable to the negative
( ) terminal on the booster battery.
d. Connect the clamp at the other end of the negative (black) jumper cable to
a solid, stationary, unpainted, metallic point of the vehicle with the discharged
battery.
The recommended connecting point is shown in the following illustration:
ccxxxii
’99camry CNG
Connecting point
Do not connect it to or near any part that moves when the engine is cranked.
CAUTION
When making the connections, to avoid serious injury, do not lean over the
battery or accidentally let the jumper cables or clamps touch anything except
the correct battery terminals or the ground.
5. Start your engine in the normal way. After starting, run it at about 2000 rpm for
several minutes with the accelerator pedal lightly depressed.
6. Carefully disconnect the cables in the exact reverse order: the negative cable
and then the positive cable.
7. Carefully dispose of the battery cover cloths—they may now contain sulfuric acid.
ccxxxiii
’99camry CNG
If your engine stalls while
8.
removed,
replace
all the battery vent plugs.
If Ifyour
vehicle
overheats
driving
If the cause of your battery discharging is not apparent (for example, lights left on),
you should have it checked.
If your engine stalls while driving...
1. Reduce your speed gradually, keeping a straight line. Move cautiously off the
road to a safe place.
2. Turn on your emergency flashers.
3. Move the ignition key back to “ACC” or “LOCK”, then try starting the engine
again.
If the engine will not start, see “If your vehicle will not start”.
CAUTION
If the engine is not running, the power assist for the brakes and steering
will not work so steering and braking will be much harder than usual.
If your engine coolant temperature gauge indicates overheating, if you experience a loss of power, or if you hear a loud knocking or pinging noise, the
engine has probably overheated. You should follow this procedure...
1. Pull safely off the road, stop the vehicle and turn on your emergency flashers.
Put the transmission in “P” and apply the parking brake. Turn off the air
conditioning if it is being used.
2. If coolant or steam is boiling out of the radiator or reservoir, stop the engine.
Wait until the steam subsides before opening the hood. If there is no coolant
boiling over or steam, leave the engine running and make sure the electric
cooling fan is operating. If it is not, turn the ignition off.
ccxxxiv
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
To help avoid personal injury, keep the hood closed until there is no steam.
Escaping steam or coolant is a sign of very high pressure.
3. Look for obvious coolant leaks from the radiator, hoses,and under the vehicle.
However, note that water draining from the air conditioning is normal if it has
been used.
CAUTION
When the engine is running, keep hands and clothing away from the moving
fan and engine drive belts.
4. If the coolant is leaking, stop the engine immediately. Call your authorized Toyota
CNG dealer for assistance.
5. If there are no obvious leaks, check the coolant reservoir. If it is dry, add
coolant to the reservoir while the engine is running. Fill it about half full.
CAUTION
Do not attempt to remove the radiator cap when the engine and radiator are
hot. Serious injury could result from scalding hot fluid and steam blown out
under pressure.
ccxxxv
’99camry CNG
6. After the engine coolant temperature has cooled to normal, again check the
coolant level in the reservoir. If necessary, bring it up to half full again. Serious
coolant loss indicates a leak in the system. You should have it checked as soon
as possible at your authorized Toyota CNG dealer.
If you have a flat tire—
1. Reduce your speed gradually, keeping a straight line. Move cautiously off the
road to a safe place well away from the traffic. Avoid stopping on the center
divider of a highway. Park on a level spot with firm ground.
2. Stop the engine and turn on your emergency flashers.
3. Firmly set the parking brake and put the transmission in “P”.
4. Have everyone get out of the vehicle on the side away from traffic.
5. Read the following instructions thoroughly.
CAUTION
When jacking, be sure to observe the following to reduce the possibility of
personal injury:
Follow jacking instructions.
Do not put any part of your body under the vehicle supported by the jack.
Personal injury may occur.
Do not start or run the engine while your vehicle is supported by the jack.
ccxxxvi
’99camry CNG
Stop the vehicle on a level firm ground, firmly set the parking brake and
put the transmission in “P”. Block the wheel diagonally opposite to the
one being changed if necessary.
Make sure to set the jack properly in the jack point. Raising the vehicle
with jack improperly positioned will damage the vehicle or may allow the
vehicle to fall off the jack and cause personal injury.
Never get under the vehicle when the vehicle is supported by the jack
alone.
Use the jack only for lifting your vehicle during wheel changing.
Do not raise the vehicle with someone in the vehicle.
When raising the vehicle, do not put an object on or under the jack.
Raise the vehicle only high enough to remove and change the tire.
NOTICE
Do not continue driving with a deflated tire. Driving even a short distance
can damage a tire beyond repair.
ccxxxvii
’99camry CNG
Compact spare tire
The compact spare tire is designed for temporary emergency use only.
The compact spare tire is identified by the distinctive wheel design and color and
special wording “TEMPORARY USE ONLY” molded into the side wall of the tire.
The standard tire should be repaired and replaced as soon as possible.
To keep the compact spare tire noticeable, do not hide the wheel by a wheel cover
or such.
The compact spare tire saves space in your trunk, and its lighter weight helps to
improve fuel economy and permits easier installation in case of a flat tire.
The compact spare tire can be used many times, if necessary. It has tread life of
up to 4800 km (3000 miles) depending on road conditions and your driving habits.
When tread wear indicators appear on the tire, replace the tire.
See also the tire section in Chapter 7–2 for details on the tread wear indicators
and other service information.
ccxxxviii
’99camry CNG
—Required tools and spare
tire
CAUTION
The compact spare tire was designed especially for your Toyota. Do not
use it on any other vehicle.
Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph) when driving with the compact spare tire.
Avoid sudden acceleration, sudden deceleration and sharp turns with the
compact spare tire.
NOTICE
Your ground clearance is reduced when the compact spare tire is installed
so avoid driving over obstacles and drive slowly on rough, unpaved roads
and speed bumps. Also, do not attempt to go through an automatic car wash
as the vehicle may get caught, resulting in damage.
ccxxxix
’99camry CNG
1. Get the required tools and spare tire.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Wheel nut wrench
Jack handle
Jack
Spare tire
To prepare yourself for an emergency, you should familiarize yourself with the use
of the jack, each of the tools and their storage locations.
ccxl
’99camry CNG
Turn the jack joint by hand.
To remove: Turn the joint in direction 1 until the jack is free.
To store: Turn the joint in direction 2 until the jack is firmly secured to prevent it
flying forward during a collision or sudden braking.
ccxli
’99camry CNG
To remove the spare tire:
1. Remove the spare tire cover.
2. Loosen the bolt and remove it.
3. Remove the spacer.
Then take the spare tire out of the vehicle.
When storing the spare tire, put it in place with the outer side of the wheel facing
up. Then secure the tire by repeating the above removal steps in reverse order to
prevent it from flying forward during a collision or sudden braking.
—Blocking the wheel
ccxlii
’99camry CNG
2. Block the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tire to keep the vehicle from
rolling when it is jacked up.
When blocking the wheel, place a wheel block from the front for the front wheels
or from the rear for the rear wheels.
—Removing wheel ornament
ccxliii
’99camry CNG
3. Remove the wheel ornament.
Pry off the wheel ornament, using the beveled end of the wheel nut wrench as
shown.
CAUTION
Do not try to pull off the ornament by hand. Take due care in handling the
ornament to avoid unexpected personal injury.
—Loosening wheel nuts
ccxliv
’99camry CNG
4. Loosen all the wheel nuts.
Always loosen the wheel nuts before raising the vehicle.
The nuts turn counterclockwise to loosen. To get maximum leverage, fit the wrench
to the nut so that the handle is on the right side, as shown above. Grab the wrench
near the end of the handle and pull up on the handle. Be careful that the wrench
does not slip off the nut.
Do not remove the nuts yet—just unscrew them about one–half turn.
—Positioning the jack
ccxlv
’99camry CNG
5. Position the jack at the correct jack point as shown.
Make sure the jack is positioned on a level and solid place.
—Raising your vehicle
ccxlvi
’99camry CNG
6. After making sure that no one is in the vehicle, raise it high enough so
that the spare tire can be installed.
Remember you will need more ground clearance when putting on the spare tire than
when removing the flat tire.
To raise the vehicle, insert the jack handle into the jack (it is a loose fit) and turn
it clockwise. As the jack touches the vehicle and begins to lift, double–check that
it is properly positioned.
CAUTION
Never get under the vehicle when the vehicle is supported by the jack alone.
—Changing wheels
7. Remove the wheel nuts and change tires.
ccxlvii
’99camry CNG
Lift the flat tire straight off and put it aside.
Roll the spare wheel into position and align the holes in the wheel with the bolts.
Then lift up the wheel and get at least the top bolt started through its hole. Wiggle
the tire and press it back over the other bolts.
Before putting on wheels, remove any corrosion on the mounting surfaces with a
wire brush or such. Installation of wheels without good metal–to–metal contact at
the mounting surface can cause wheel nuts to loosen and eventually cause a wheel
to come off while driving. Therefore after the first 1600 km (1000 miles), check to
see that the wheel nuts are tight.
—Reinstalling wheel nuts
ccxlviii
’99camry CNG
8. Reinstall all the wheel nuts finger tight.
Reinstall the wheel nuts (tapered end inward) and tighten them as much as you
can by hand. Press back on the tire and see if you can tighten them more.
—Lowering your vehicle
ccxlix
’99camry CNG
9. Lower the vehicle completely and tighten the wheel nuts.
Turn the jack handle counterclockwise to lower the vehicle.
Use only the wheel nut wrench to tighten the nuts. Do not use other tools or any
additional leverage other than your hands, such as a hammer, pipe or your foot.
Make sure the wrench is securely engaged over the nut.
Tighten each nut a little at a time in the order shown. Repeat the process until
all the nuts are tight.
CAUTION
When lowering the vehicle, make sure all portions of your body and all other
persons around will not be injured as the vehicle is lowered to the ground.
—Reinstalling wheel ornament
ccl
’99camry CNG
10. Reinstall the wheel ornament.
1. Put the wheel ornament into position.
Align the cutout of the wheel ornament with the valve stem as shown.
2. Then tap it firmly with the side or heel of your hand to snap it into place.
CAUTION
Take due care in handling the ornament to avoid unexpected personal injury.
—After changing wheels
11. Check the air pressure of the replaced tire.
Adjust the air pressure to the specification designed in Part 8. If the pressure is
lower, drive slowly to the nearest service station and fill to the correct pressure.
ccli
’99camry CNG
If your vehicle needs to be
Do
not forget to reinstall the tire inflation valve cap as dirt and moisture could get
towed—
into the valve core and possibly cause air leakage. If the cap is missing, have a
new one put on as soon as possible.
12. Restow all the tools, jack and flat tire securely.
As soon after changing wheels as possible, tighten the wheel nuts to the torque
specified in Part 8 with a torque wrench and have a technician repair the flat tire.
CAUTION
Before driving, make sure all the tools, jack and flat tire are securely in
place in their storage location to reduce the possibility of personal injury
during a collision or sudden braking.
cclii
’99camry CNG
(a) Towing with wheel lift type truck—
—From front
—From rear
(b) Using flat bed truck
ccliii
’99camry CNG
If towing is necessary, we recommend you to have it done by your authorized
Toyota CNG dealer or a commercial tow truck service. In consultation with
them, have your vehicle towed using either (a) or (b).
Only when you cannot receive a towing service from your authorized Toyota
CNG dealer or a commercial tow truck service, tow your vehicle carefully in
accordance with the instructions given in “—Emergency towing” in this part.
Proper equipment will help ensure that your vehicle is not damaged while being
towed. Commercial operators are generally aware of the state/provincial and local
laws pertaining to towing.
Your vehicle can be damaged if it is towed incorrectly. Although most operators
know the correct procedure, it is possible to make a mistake. To avoid damage to
your vehicle, make sure the following few precautions are observed. If necessary,
show this page to the tow truck driver.
TOWING PRECAUTIONS:
Use a safety chain system for all towing, and abide by the state/provincial and local
laws. The wheels and axle on the ground must be in good condition. If they are
damaged, use a towing dolly.
(a) Towing with wheel lift type truck
From front—Release the parking brake.
NOTICE
When lifting wheels, take care to ensure adequate ground clearance for
towing at the opposite end of the raised vehicle. Otherwise, the bumper
and/or underbody of the towed vehicle will be damaged during towing.
From rear—Use a towing dolly under the front wheels.
ccliv
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Never tow a vehicle with an automatic transmission from the rear with the
front wheels on the ground, as this may cause serious damage to the
transmission.
(b) Using flat bed truck
(c) Towing with sling type
truck
(c) Towing with sling type truck
NOTICE
Do not tow with sling type truck, either from the front or rear. This may
cause body damage.
—Emergency towing
cclv
’99camry CNG
If towing is necessary, we recommend you to have it done by your authorized
Toyota CNG dealer or a commercial tow truck service.
If towing service is not available in an emergency, your vehicle may be temporarily towed by a cable or chain secured to one of the emergency towing
eyelets under the vehicle. Use extreme caution when towing vehicles.
A driver must be in the vehicle to steer it and operate the brakes.
Towing in this manner may be done only on hard–surfaced roads for a short
distance and at low speeds. Also, the wheels, axles, drive train,steering and brakes
must all be in good condition.
cclvi
’99camry CNG
If you cannot shift automatic
transmission selector lever
CAUTION
Use extreme caution when towing vehicles. Avoid sudden starts or erratic
driving maneuvers which would place excessive stress on the emergency
towing eyelets and towing cable or chain. The eyelets and towing cable or
chain may break and cause serious injury or damage.
NOTICE
Use only a cable or chain specifically intended for use in towing vehicles.
Securely fasten the cable or chain to the towing eyelets provided.
Before towing, release the parking brake and put the transmission in “N”. The key
must be in “ACC” (engine off) or “ON” (engine running).
CAUTION
If the engine is not running, the power assist for the brakes and steering
will not work so steering and braking will be much harder than usual.
cclvii
’99camry CNG
If you cannot shift the selector lever out of “P” position to other positions
even though the brake pedal is depressed, use the shift lock override button
as follows:
1. Turn the ignition key to “LOCK” position. Make sure the parking brake is
on.
2. Pry up the cover with a flat–bladed screwdriver or equivalent.
cclviii
’99camry CNG
3. Insert your finger into the hole to push down the shift lock override button.
You can shift out of “P” position only while pushing the button.
4. Shift into “N” position.
5. Insert the cover.
6. Start the engine. For your safety, keep the brake pedal depressed.
Be sure to have the system checked by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer as
soon as possible.
If you lose your keys
Your authorized Toyota CNG dealer can make a new key if you can give them
the key number.
See the suggestion given in “Keys” in Chapter 1–2.
If your keys are locked in the vehicle and you cannot get a duplicate, your
authorized Toyota CNG dealer can still open the door for you, using their special
tools. If you must break a window to get in, we suggest breaking the smallest side
cclix
’99camry CNG
If you suspect the fuel is
window
because it is the least expensive to replace. Be extremely cautious to avoid
leaking
cuts from the glass.
cclx
’99camry CNG
Open
Close
cclxi
’99camry CNG
If you smell fuel or hear the sound of leaking fuel at anytime or if your vehicle
is involved in an accident, immediately close the manual shut off valve to shut
the fuel off.
The manual shut off valve is intended to shut the fuel from the tank off. Normally
it is left open.
To close: Turn the lever clockwise 90°.
To open: Turn the lever counterclockwise 90°.
If you suspect a fuel leakage, close the manual shut off valve and have your
vehicle serviced by your authorized Toyota CNG dealer as soon as possible.
If, due to a collision or similar circumstances, the fuel system may be damaged,
close the manual shut off value, and contact your authorized Toyota CNG dealer
to have the fuel system checked for fuel leakage.
CAUTION
If you smell or hear fuel leaking, shut off the fuel system immediately. If
leaking fuel is ignited, an explosion or fire could occur, causing death or
serious injury.
Do not inhale a large amount of leaked fuel. Inhaling the natural gas
continuously may cause the lack of oxygen in your body.
If you suspect a fuel leakage, do not park the vehicle in an enclosed area
such as a garage, or the leaked fuel may fill the area and cause a fire
or explosion.
If you suspect the fuel is leaking while refueling, stop refueling immediately. If leaking fuel is ignited, an explosion or fire could occur, causing death
or serious injury.
cclxii
’99camry CNG
cclxiii
’99camry CNG
Protecting your Toyota
from corrosion
Part
5
CORROSION
PREVENTION AND
APPEARANCE CARE
Protecting your Toyota from
corrosion
Washing and waxing your Toyota
Cleaning the interior
Toyota, through its diligent research, design and use of the most advanced technology available, has done its part to help prevent corrosion and has provided you with
the finest quality vehicle construction. Now, it is up to you. Proper care of your
Toyota can help ensure long–term corrosion prevention.
The most common causes of corrosion to your vehicle are:
The accumulation of road salt, dirt and moisture in hard–to–reach areas under
the vehicle.
Chipping of paint, or undercoating caused by minor accidents or by stones and
gravel.
Care is especially important if you live in particular areas or operate your
vehicle under certain environmental conditions:
Road salt or dust control chemicals will accelerate corrosion, as will the presence of salt in the air near the sea–coast or in areas of industrial pollution.
High humidity accelerates corrosion especially when temperatures range just
above the freezing point.
cclxiv
’99camry CNG
Wetness or dampness to certain parts of your vehicle for an extended period
of time, may cause corrosion even though other parts of the vehicle may be dry.
High temperatures will cause corrosion to those components of the vehicle which
are prevented from quick–drying due to lack of proper ventilation.
The above signifies the necessity to keep your vehicle, particularly the underside,
as clean as possible and to repair any damage to paint or protective coatings as
soon as possible.
To help prevent corrosion on your Toyota, follow these guidelines:
Wash your vehicle frequently. It is, of course, necessary to keep your vehicle
clean by regular washing, but to prevent corrosion, the following points should be
observed:
If you drive on salted roads in the winter or if you live near the ocean, you
should hose off the undercarriage at least once a month to minimize corrosion.
High pressure water or steam is effective for cleaning the vehicle’s underside
and wheel housings. Pay particular attention to these areas as it is difficult to
see all the mud and dirt. It will do more harm than good to simply wet the mud
and debris without removing them. The lower edge of doors, rocker panels and
frame members have drain holes which should not be allowed to clog with dirt
as trapped water in these areas can cause corrosion.
Wash the underside of the vehicle thoroughly when winter is over.
See “Washing and waxing your Toyota” for more tips.
Check the condition of your vehicle’s paint and trim. If you find any chips or
scratches in the paint, touch them up immediately to prevent corrosion from starting.
If the chips or scratches have gone through the bare metal, have a qualified body
shop make the repair.
cclxv
’99camry CNG
Washing and waxing your
Toyota
Check the interior of your vehicle. Water and dirt can accumulate under the floor
mats and could cause corrosion. Occasionally check under the mats to make sure
the area is dry. Be particularly careful when transporting chemicals, cleansers,
fertilizers, salt, etc.; these should be transported in proper containers. If a spill or
leak should occur, immediately clean and dry the area.
Use mud shields on your wheels. If you drive on salted or gravel roads, mud
shields help protect your vehicle. Full–size shields, which come as near to the
ground as possible, are the best. We recommend that the fittings and the area
where the shields are installed be treated to resist corrosion. Your authorized Toyota
CNG dealer will be happy to assist in supplying and installing the shields if they
are recommended for your area.
Keep your vehicle in a well ventilated garage or a roofed place. Do not park
your vehicle in a damp, poorly ventilated garage. If you wash your vehicle in
the garage, or if you drive it in covered with water or snow, your garage may be
so damp it will cause corrosion. Even if your garage is heated, a wet vehicle can
corrode if the ventilation is poor.
Washing your Toyota
Keep your vehicle clean by regular washing.
The following cases may cause weakness to the paint or corrosion to the body and
parts. Wash your vehicle as soon as possible.
When driving in a coastal area
When driving on a road sprinkled with antifreeze
When having stuck of coal tar, tree sap, bird droppings and carcass of an insect
When driving in the areas where there is a lot of smoke, soot, dust, iron dust
and chemical substance
When the vehicle becomes remarkably dirty with dust and mud
cclxvi
’99camry CNG
Hand–washing your Toyota
Work in the shade and wait until the vehicle body is not hot to the touch.
CAUTION
When cleaning under floor or chassis, be careful not to injure your hands.
1. Rinse off loose dirt with a hose. Remove any mud or road salt from the
underside of the vehicle or in the wheel wells.
2. Wash with a mild car–wash soap, mixed according to the manufacturer’s instructions. Use a soft cotton mitt and keep it wet by dipping it frequently into the
wash water. Do not rub hard—let the soap and water remove the dirt.
Plastic bumpers: Wash carefully. Do not scrub with abrasive cleaners. The bumper
faces are soft.
Road tar: Remove with turpentine or cleaners that are marked safe for painted
surfaces.
NOTICE
Do not use gasoline or strong solvents, which may be toxic or cause damage.
3. Rinse thoroughly—dried soap can cause streaking. In hot weather you may need
to rinse each section right after you wash it.
4. To prevent water spots, dry the vehicle using a clean soft cotton towel. Do not
rub or press hard—you might scratch the paint.
Automatic car wash
cclxvii
’99camry CNG
Your vehicle may be washed in an automatic car wash, but remember that the paint
can be scratched by some type of brushes, unfiltered washing water, or the washing
process itself. Scratching reduces paint durability and gloss, especially on darker
colors. The manager of the car wash should be able to advise you whether the
process is safe for the paint on your vehicle.
Waxing your Toyota
Polishing and waxing is recommended to maintain the original beauty of your
Toyota’s finish.
Once a month or if the vehicle does not repel water well, apply wax.
1. Always wash and dry the vehicle before you begin waxing, even if you are using
a combined cleaner and wax.
2. Use a good quality polish and wax. If the finish has become extremely weathered, use a car–cleaning polish, followed by a separate wax. Carefully follow the
manufacturer’s instructions and precautions. Be sure to polish and wax the
chrome trim as well as the paint.
3. Wax the vehicle again when water does not bead but remains on the surface
in large patches.
NOTICE
Always remove the plastic bumpers if your vehicle is re–painted and placed
in a high heat paint waxing booth. High temperatures could damage the
bumpers.
Cleaning the interior
cclxviii
’99camry CNG
CAUTION
Do not wash the vehicle floor with water, or allow water to get onto the floor
when cleaning the vehicle interior or exterior. Water may get into audio
components or other electrical components above or under the floor carpet
(or mat) and cause a malfunction; and it may cause body corrosion.
Vinyl interior
The vinyl upholstery may be easily cleaned with a mild soap or detergent and
water.
First vacuum over the upholstery to remove loose dirt. Then, using a sponge or
soft cloth, apply the soap solution to the vinyl. After allowing it to soak in for a
few minutes to loosen the dirt, remove the dirt and wipe off the soap with a clean
damp cloth. If all the dirt do not come off, repeat the procedure. Commercial
foaming–type vinyl cleaners are also available which work well. Follow the manufacturer’s instructions.
NOTICE
Do not use solvent, thinner, gasoline or window cleaner on the interior.
Carpets
Use a good foam–type shampoo to clean the carpets.
Begin by vacuuming thoroughly to remove as much dirt as possible. Several types
of foam cleaners are available; some are in aerosol can sand others are powders
or liquids which you mix with water to produce a foam. To shampoo the carpets,
use a sponge or brush to apply the foam. Rub in overlapping circles.
cclxix
’99camry CNG
Do not apply water—the best results are obtained by keeping the carpet as dry as
possible. Read the shampoo instructions and follow them closely.
Seat belts
The seat belts may be cleaned with mild soap and water or with lukewarm
water.
Use a cloth or sponge. As you are cleaning, check the belts for excessive wear,
fraying, or cuts.
NOTICE
Do not use dye or bleach on the belts—it may weaken them.
Do not use the belts until they become dry.
Windows
The windows may be cleaned with any household window cleaner.
NOTICE
When cleaning the inside of the windows, be careful not to scratch or
damage the heater wires on the rear window.
Air conditioning control panel, car audio, instrument panel, console panel, and
switches
Use a soft damp cloth for cleaning.
Soak a clean soft cloth in water or lukewarm water then lightly wipe off dirt.
cclxx
’99camry CNG
NOTICE
Do not use organic substances (solvents, kerosene, alcohol, gasoline, etc.)
or alkaline or acidic solutions. These chemicals can cause discoloring,
staining or peeling of the surface.
If you use cleaners or polishing agents, make sure their ingredients do not
include the substances mentioned above.
If you use a liquid car freshener, do not spill the liquid onto the vehicle’s
interior surfaces. It may contain the ingredients mentioned above. Immediately clean any spill using the method mentioned above.
If you have any questions about the cleaning of your Toyota, your authorized
Toyota CNG dealer will be pleased to answer them.
cclxxi
’99camry CNG
cclxxii
’99camry CNG
Part 6
VEHICLE
MAINTENANCE
AND CARE
Maintenance requirements
General maintenance
Does your vehicle need
repairing?
For scheduled maintenance
information, please refer to the
separate “Owner’s Manual
Supplement”.
Maintenance requirements
Your Toyota vehicle has been designed to for fewer maintenance requirements with
longer service intervals to save both your time and money. However, each regular
cclxxiii
’99camry CNG
maintenance, as well as day–to–day care, is more important than ever before to
ensure smooth, trouble–free, safe, and economical drivings.
It is the owner’s responsibility to make sure the specified maintenance, including
general maintenance service, is performed. Note that both the new vehicle and
emission control system warranties specify that proper maintenance and care must
be performed. See “Owner’s Manual Supplement”.
General maintenance
General maintenance items are those day–to–day care practices that are important
to your vehicle for proper operation. It is the owner’s responsibility to insure that
the general maintenance items are performed regularly.
These checks or inspections can be done either by yourself or a qualified technician, or if you prefer, your authorized Toyota CNG dealer will be pleased to do them
at a nominal cost.
Scheduled maintenance
The scheduled maintenance items listed in the “Owner’s Manual Supplement” are
those required to be serviced at regular intervals.
For details of your maintenance schedule, read the separate “Owner’s Manual
Supplement”.
It is recommended that any replacement parts used for maintenance or for the
repair of the emission control system be Toyota supplied.
The owner may elect to use non–Toyota supplied parts for replacement purposes without invalidating the emission control system warranty. However, use
of replacement parts which are not of equivalent quality may impair the effectiveness of the emission control systems.
You may also elect to have maintenance, replacement, or repair of the
emission control devices and system performed by any automotive repair
cclxxiv
’99camry CNG
establishment or individual without invalidating this warranty. See “Owner’s
Manual Supplement” for complete warranty information.
Where to go for service?
Toyota technicians are well–trained specialists and are kept up to date with the
latest service information through technical bulletins, service tips, and in–dealership
training programs. They learn to work on Toyotas before they work on your vehicle,
rather than while they are working on it.
You can be confident that your authorized Toyota CNG dealer’s service department
performs the best job to meet the maintenance requirements on your vehicle—reliably and economically.
Your copy of the repair order is proof that all required maintenance has been
performed for warranty coverage. And if any problems should arise with your vehicle
while under warranty, your authorized Toyota CNG dealer will promptly take care of
it. Again, be sure to keep a copy of the repair order for any service performed on
your Toyota.
What about do–it–yourself maintenance?
Many of the maintenance items are easy to do yourself if you have a little
mechanical ability and a few basic automotive tools. Simple instructions for how to
perform them are presented in Part 7.
If you are a skilled do–it–yourself mechanic, the Toyota service manuals are
recommended. Please be aware that do–it–yourself maintenance can affect your
warranty coverage. See “Owner’s Manual Supplement” for the details.
General maintenance
Listed below are the general maintenance items that should be performed as
frequently as specified. In addition to checking the items listed, if you notice any
unusual noise, smell or vibration, you should investigate the cause or take your
cclxxv
’99camry CNG
vehicle to your authorized Toyota CNG dealer or a qualified service shop immediately. It is recommended that any problem you notice be brought to the attention of
your dealer or the qualified service shop for their advice.
CAUTION
Make these checks only where adequate ventilation can be obtained if you
run the engine.
OUTSIDE THE VEHICLE
Items listed below should be performed from time to time, unless otherwise
specified.
Tire pressure
Check the pressure with a gauge every two weeks, or at least once a month. See
Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Tire surface and wheel nuts
Check the tires carefully for cuts, damage or excessive wear. See Chapter 7–2 for
additional information. When checking the tires, make sure no nuts are missing, and
check the nuts for looseness. Tighten them if necessary.
Tire rotation
Rotate the tires every 12000 km (7500 miles). See Chapter 7–2 for additional
information.
Fluid leaks
Check underneath for leaking oil, water or other fluid after the vehicle has been
parked for a while. If you smell fuel fumes or notice any leak, have the cause found
and corrected immediately.
cclxxvi
’99camry CNG
Doors and engine hood
Check that all doors including trunk lid operate smoothly and all latches lock
securely. Make sure the engine hood secondary latch secures the hood from
opening when the primary latch is released.
INSIDE THE VEHICLE
Items listed below should be checked regularly, e.g. while performing periodic
services, cleaning the vehicle, etc.
Lights
Make sure the headlights, stop lights, tail lights, turn signal lights, and other lights
are all working. Check headlight aim.
Service reminder indicators and warning buzzers
Check that all service reminder indicators and warning buzzers function properly.
Steering wheel
Be alert for changes in steering condition, such as hard steering or strange noise.
Seats
Check that all front seat controls such as seat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc.
operate smoothly and that all latches lock securely in any position. Check that the
head restraints move up and down smoothly and that the locks hold securely in
any latched position.
Seat belts
Check that the seat belt system such as buckles, retractors and anchors operate
properly and smoothly. Make sure that the belt webbings not cut, frayed, worn or
damaged.
Accelerator pedal
Check the pedal for smooth operation and uneven pedal effort or catching.
cclxxvii
’99camry CNG
Brake pedal
Check the pedal for smooth operation and that the pedal has the proper clearance.
Check the brake booster function.
Brakes
At a safe place, check that the brakes do not pull to one side when applied.
Parking brake
Check that the lever has the proper travel and that, on a safe incline, your vehicle
is held securely with only the parking brake applied.
Automatic transmission “Park” mechanism
Check the lock release button of the selector lever for proper and smooth operation.
On a safe incline, check that your vehicle is held securely with the selector lever
in “P” position and all brakes released.
IN THE ENGINE COMPARTMENT
Items listed below should be checked from time to time, e.g. each time when
refueling.
Washer fluid
Make sure there is sufficient fluid in the tank. See Chapter 7–3 for additional
information.
Engine coolant level
Make sure the coolant level is between the “FULL” and “LOW” lines on the see–
through reservoir when the engine is cold. See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Battery electrolyte level
Make sure the electrolyte level of all battery cells is between upper and lower level
lines on the case. Add only distilled water when replenishing. See Chapter 7–3 for
additional information.
cclxxviii
’99camry CNG
Does your vehicle need
Brake
fluid level
repairing?
Make sure the brake fluid level is correct. See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Engine oil level
Check the level on the dipstick with the engine turned off and the vehicle parked
on a level spot. See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Power steering fluid level
Check the level through the reservoir. The level should be in the “HOT” or “COLD”
range depending on the fluid temperature. See Chapter 7–2 for additional information.
Exhaust system
If you notice any change in the sound of the exhaust or smell exhaust fumes, have
the cause located and corrected immediately. (See engine exhaust cautions in Part
2.)
Be on the alert for changes in performance, sounds, and visual tip–offs that indicate
service is needed. Some important clues are as follows:
Engine missing, stumbling, or pinging
Appreciable loss of power
Strange engine noises
A leak under the vehicle (however, water dripping from the air conditioning after
use is normal.)
Change in exhaust sound (This may indicate a dangerous carbon monoxide leak.
Drive with the windows open and have the exhaust system checked immediately.)
Flat–looking tire; excessive tire squeal when cornering; uneven tire wear
Vehicle pulls to one side when driving straight on a level road
cclxxix
’99camry CNG
Strange noises related to suspension movement
Loss of brake effectiveness; spongy feeling brake; pedal almost touches floor;
vehicle pulls to one side when braking
Engine coolant temperature continually higher than normal
If you notice any of these clues, take your vehicle to your authorized Toyota CNG
dealer as soon as possible. It probably needs adjustment or repair.
CAUTION
Do not continue driving with the vehicle unchecked. It could result in serious
vehicle damage and possibly personal injury.
cclxxx
’99camry CNG
cclxxxi
’99camry CNG
Part 8
SPECIFICATIONS
Dimensions and weight
Engine
Fuel
Service specifications
Tires
Fuses
Dimensions and weight
Overall length
mm (in.)
4783 (188.3)
Overall width
mm (in.)
1780
(70.1)
Overall height
mm (in.)
1419
(55.9)∗
Wheelbase
mm (in.)
2670 (105.1)
Front tread
mm (in.)
1547
(61.0)
Rear tread
mm (in.)
1520
(59.8)
Vehicle capacity weight
(occupants + luggage)
kg (lb)
410
(900)
∗:
Unladen vehicle
Engine
Model:
5S–FNE
cccxxxviii
’99camry CNG
Type:
4 cylinder in line, CNG (Compressed Natural Gas)
Bore and stroke, mm (in.):
87.0 91.0 (3.43 3.58)
Displacement, cm3 (cu. in.):
2164 (132.0)
Fuel
Fuel type:
Compressed natural gas
Service pressure:
24800 kPa (3600 psig)
Equivalent gasoline capacity:
43 L (11.4 gal., 9.5 lmp.gal.)
Water volume:
135 L (35.7 gal., 29.7 lmp.gal.)
Service specifications
ENGINE
Valve clearance (engine cold), mm (in.):
Intake
0.19—0.29 (0.007—0.011)
Exhaust 0.28—0.38 (0.011—0.015)
Spark plug type:
DENSO
PK20TR8–G
Spark plug gap, mm(in.):
0.8 (0.031)
Drive belt tension measured with Borroughs drive belt tension gauge No.BT–33–73F
(used belt), Ibf:
With air conditioning
Generator belt
13010
cccxxxix
’99camry CNG
Power steering pump belt
Without air conditioning
Generator belt
Power steering pump belt
8020
6520
8020
ENGINE LUBRICATION
Oil capacity (drain and refill), L (qt., Imp. qt.):
With filter
Without filter
3.6 (3.8, 3.2)
3.4 (3.6, 3.0)
Oil grade:
API grade SJ, “Energy–Conserving” or ILSAC multigrade engine oil is recommended.
Recommended oil viscosity (SAE):
COOLING SYSTEM
Total capacity, L (qt., Imp. qt.):
6.9 (7.3, 6.1)
cccxl
’99camry CNG
Coolant type:
“TOYOTA Long Life Coolant” or equivalent
With ethylene–glycol type coolant for a proper corrosion protection of aluminum
components
Do not use alcohol type antifreeze or plain water alone.
BATTERY
Open voltage∗ at 20C (68F):
12.6—12.8V Fully charged
12.2—12.4V Half charged
11.8—12.0V Discharged
∗:
Voltage that is checked 20 minutes after the key is removed with all the lights
turned off
Charging rates:
5 A max.
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Automatic transmission
Fluid capacity (drain and refill),
L (qt., Imp. qt.):
Up to 2.5 (2.6, 2.2)
Fluid type:
Automatic transmission fluid D–ll or DEXRONIIl (DEXRONII)
Differential
Fluid capacity L (qt., Imp. qt.):
1.6 (1.7, 1.4)
Fluid type:
Automatic transmission fluid D–II or DEXRONIII (DEXRONII)
cccxli
’99camry CNG
BRAKES
Minimum
pedal clearance when depressed with the pressure of 490 N (50 kgf, 110
Tire size:
lbf) with the engine running, mm (in.):
Spare tire
T145/80R16 105M
70 (2.8)
Except
spare mm
tire (in.):P205/65R15 92H
Pedal
free play,
Tire pressure,
kPa (kgf/cm2 or bar, psi):
1—6
(0.04—0.24)
Pad Spare
wear tire
limit, mm (in.): 420 (4.2, 60)
1.0Except
(0.04) spare tire
Lining wear limit, mm (in.):
For all loads including full rated loads
220 (2.2, 32)
1.0 Normal
(0.04)
driving
For reduced loads (1 to 4 passengers)
200 (2.0, 29)
Parking brake adjustment when pulled with the force of 196 N (20 kgf, 44 lbf):
220 (2.2, 32)
5—8 Trailer
clicks driving
When driving under the above vehicle load conditions at sustained high speeds
above 160 km/h (100 mph), in countries where such speeds are permitted
Fluid type:
by–law, inflate the front and rear tires to 240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2 or bar, 35 psi)
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3
provided that it dose not exceed the maximum cold tire pressure molded on
STEERING
the tire sidewall.
Wheelfree
size:
Wheel
play:
Less
than
in.)
Spare
tire30 mm (1.2 4T
Power
steering
Except
sparefluid
tire type: 15 6JJ
Automatic transmission fluid DEXRONII or III
Wheel nut torque, N·m (kgf·m, ft·lbf):
Tires
104 (10.5, 77)
Fuses
cccxlii
’99camry CNG
Engine compartment
cccxliii
’99camry CNG
Engine compartment
Fuses (type A)
1. A/C 10 A: Air conditioning system
2. SPARE 10 A: Spare fuse
3. SPARE 15 A: Spare fuse
4. SPARE 30 A: Spare fuse
5. ALT–S 5 A: Charging system
6. HEAD (RH) 15 A: Right–hand headlight
7. EFI 15 A: Multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system, A/F sensor
8. HORN 10 A: Horn
9. HAZARD 10 A: Emergency flasher
cccxliv
’99camry CNG
Instrument panel
10. AM2 30 A: Gauge and meter, SRS airbag system, seat belt pretensioners,
multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system, “IGN”
and “STARTER” fuses
11. TEL 5 A: No circuit
12. HEAD (LH) 15 A: Left–hand headlight
13. RADIO NO.1 20 A: Audio system
14. DOME 7.5 A: Clock, ignition switch light, personal light, trunk light, interior light,
power door lock system
15. ECU–B 10 A: Anti–lock brake system, SRS airbag system, seat belt pretensioners
16. A/F HTR 25 A: No circuit
cccxlv
’99camry CNG
17. SEAT–HEATER 20 A: No circuit
18. HEATER 10 A: Air conditioning system, rear window defogger
19. GAUGE 10 A: Gauges and meters, back–up lights, cruise control system, charging system, power windows, service reminder indicators and warning buzzers
20. WIPER 25 A: Windshield wipers and washer
21. MIRROR–HEATER 10 A: Outside rear view mirror defogger
22. ECU–IG 15 A: Cruise control system, anti–lock brake system, power antenna,
SRS airbag system, seat belt pretensioners, shift lock control system, multiport
fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system
23. IGN 5 A: Gauges and meters, charging system, SRS airbag system, seat belt
pretensioners, multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection
system
24. STOP 15 A: Stop lights, cruise control system, high–mounted stoplight, anti–lock
brake system, shift lock control system, multiport fuel injection system/sequential
multiport fuel injection system
25. TAIL 10 A: Parking lights, license plate lights, tail lights, front side marker lights,
multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system
26. POWER–OUTLET 15 A: Power outlet
27. OBD 7.5 A: On–board diagnosis system
28. FOG 15 A: No circuit
29. STARTER 5 A: Gauges and meters, multiport fuel injection system/sequential
multiport fuel injection system
30. DOOR 25 A: Power door lock system
cccxlvi
’99camry CNG
31. PANEL 7.5 A: Gauge and meter, audio system, cigarette lighter, glove box light,
clock, instrument panel light control, service reminder indicators, air conditioning
control panel lights, ashtray light, emergency flasher, rear window defogger,
electronically controlled automatic transmission system
32. TURN 7.5 A: Emergency flasher
33. RAD–NO.2 7.5 A: Audio system
34. CIG 15 A: Cigarette lighter, shift lock control system, power rear view mirror
controls, power door lock system, SRS airbag system, seat belt pretensioners,
air conditioning system
Fuses (type B)
35. CDS 30 A: Electric cooling fans
36. RDI 30 A: Electric cooling fans
37. MAIN 40 A: “HEAD RH”, “HEAD LH”, fuses
38. HTR 50 A: “AM1” and “A/C” fuses
39. DEF 40 A: Rear window defogger
40. PWR 30 A: Power window control system
41. AM1 40 A: “POWER–OUTLET”, “CIG”, “RAD–NO.2”, “SEAT–HEATER”, “TURN”,
“WIP”, “ECU–IG”, “GAUGE”, and “HTR” fuses
42. CDS NO.2 30 A: No Circuit
Fuses (type C)
43. ALT 100 A: “RDI” and “CDS” fuses
44. ABS 60 A: Anti–lock brake system
cccxlvii
’99camry CNG
Reporting safety defects
for U.S.
Part
9 owners
REPORTING SAFETY
DEFECTS FOR U.S. OWNERS AND
UNIFORM TIRE
QUALITY GRADING
Reporting safety defects for
U.S. owners
Uniform tire quality grading
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a
crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform
the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc.
(Toll–free: 1–800–331–4331).
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation,
and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it
may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot
become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or
Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety Hotline toll–
free at 1–800–424–9393 (or 366–0123 in Washington, D.C. area) or
cccxlviii
’99camry CNG
write to: NHTSA. U.S. Department of Transportation. Washington, D.C.
20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from the Hotline.
Uniform tire quality grading
This information has been prepared in accordance with regulations issued by the
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration of the U.S. Department of Transportation. It provides the purchasers and/or prospective purchasers of Toyota vehicles
with information on uniform tire quality grading.
Your authorized Toyota CNG dealer will help answer any questions you may have
as you read this information.
DOT quality grades—All passenger vehicle tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition to these grades. These quality grades are molded
on the sidewall.
Treadwear—The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate
of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test
course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and a half (1–1/2) times
as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance
of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart
significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and
differences in road characteristics and climate.
Traction AA, A, B, C—The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,
and C, and they represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and
concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.
Warning: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on braking (straight
ahead) traction tests and does not include cornering (turning) traction.
cccxlix
’99camry CNG
Temperature A, B, C—The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate
heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test
wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate
and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The
grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must
meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A
represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.
Warning: The temperature grades for this tire are established for a tire that is
properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive
loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible
tire failure.
cccl
’99camry CNG
Part 10
INDEX
cccli
Foreword
Welcome to the growing group of value–conscious people who drive Toyotas. We
are proud of the advanced engineering and quality construction of each vehicle we
build.
This Owner’s Manual explains the features of your new Toyota. Please read it and
follow the instructions carefully so that you can enjoy many years of safe motoring.
When it comes to service, remember that your authorized Toyota CNG dealer knows
your vehicle best and is interested in your complete satisfaction. He will provide
quality maintenance and any other assistance you may require.
Please leave this Owner’s Manual in this vehicle at the time of resale. The next
owner will need this information also.
All information and specifications in this manual are current at the time of
printing. However, because of Toyota’s policy of continual product improvement, we reserve the right to make changes at any time without notice.
Please note that this manual applies to all models and explains all equipment,
including options. Therefore, you may find some explanations for equipment
not installed on your vehicle.
1999
TOYOTA MOTOR CORPORATION
All rights reserved. This material may not be reproduced or copied, in whole or in
part, without the written permission of Toyota Motor Corporation.
i
Important information about this manual
Safety and vehicle damage warnings
Safety symbol
In this manual, you will see CAUTION and NOTICE warnings. These are used in the following ways:
CAUTION
This is a warning against something which may
cause injury to people if the warning is ignored.
You are informed what you must or must not do in
order to avoid or reduce the risk to yourself and
other people.
NOTICE
This is a warning against something which may
cause damage to the vehicle or its equipment if the
warning is ignored. You are informed what you
must or must not do in order to avoid or reduce
the risk of damage to your vehicle and its equipment.
ccclv
In this manual, you will also see a circle
with a slash through it. This means “Do
not”, “Do not do this”, or “Do not let this
happen”.
U−1
Quick index
If a service reminder indicator or warning buzzer comes on . . . . . . . . cxxiii
If your vehicle will not start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ccxxviii
If your engine stalls while driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ccxxxiv
If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ccxxxiv
If you have a flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ccxxxvi
If your vehicle needs to be towed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . cclii
Tips for driving during break–in period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . clxxxviii
How to start the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ccxi
General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . cclxxv
Complete index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . cccli
Gas station information
Fuel type:
Compressed natural gas
See page clxxxviii for detailed information.
Service pressure:
24800 kPa (3600 psig)
Equivalent gasoline capacity:
43 L (11.4 gal., 9.5 lmp. gal.)
Water volume:
135 L (35.7 gal., 29.7 lmp. gal.)
See page cxcii for detailed information.
Engine oil:
API grade SJ, “Energy–Conserving” or ILSAC multigrade engine oil
is recommended.
See page ccxciv for detailed information.
Automatic transmission fluid:
Automatic transmission fluid D–II or DEXRONIII (DEXRONII)
Tire information: See pages ccci through cccviii.
Tire pressure: See page cccxlii.
Publication No. OM33502U
Part No. 01999-33502
Printed in Japan 01–9903–00
CNG (
U)
I
New vehicle warranty
Accessories, spare parts and
modification of your Toyota
Your new vehicle is covered by the following Toyota
limited warranties:
A wide variety of non–genuine spare parts and accessories for Toyota vehicles are currently available in the
market. You should know that Toyota does not warrant
these products and is not responsible either for their
performance, repair or replacement, or for any damage
they may cause to, or adverse effect they may have on,
your Toyota vehicle.
New vehicle warranty
Emission control systems warranty
Others
For further information, please refer to the separate
“Owner’s Manual Supplement”.
Your responsibility for maintenance
It is owner’s responsibility to make sure that the specified maintenance is performed. Part 6 gives details of
these maintenance requirements. Also included in Part 6
is general maintenance. For scheduled maintenance information, please refer to the separate “Owner’s Manual
Supplement”.
ccclii
This vehicle should not be modified with non–genuine
Toyota products. Modification with non–genuine Toyota
products could affect its performance, safety or durability, and may even violate governmental regulations. In
addition, damage or performance problems resulting from
the modification may not be covered under warranty.
Installation of a mobile
two–way radio system
Precautions for CNG
Your vehicle may use compressed natural gas (CNG) for
fuel.
As the installation of a mobile two–way radio system in
your vehicle could affect electronic systems such as
multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel
injection system, cruise control system, anti–lock brake
system, SRS airbag system and seat belt pretensioner
system, be sure to check with your authorized Toyota
CNG dealer for precautionary measures or special
instructions regarding installation.
Handle the CNG vehicle with care as the fuel tank
and pipes of it are filled with extremely high pressure gas. In this case, close the manual shut off
valve and have your authorized Toyota CNG dealer
carry out an inspection.
You will be able to tell if fuel is leaking out of the
vehicle by the sound of the leaking fuel and the
smell of the fuel.
Be careful not to run out of fuel. There are less
CNG stations than gasoline stations so we recommend that you refuel early.
Scrapping of your Toyota
For details, see “Fuel” and “Fuel system” in Part 2.
The SRS airbag and seat belt pretensioner devices in
your Toyota contain explosive chemicals. If the vehicle
is scrapped with the airbags and pretensioners left as
they are, it may cause an accident such as a fire. Be
sure to have the systems of the SRS airbag and seat
belt pretensioner removed and disposed of by the qualified service shop or by your authorized Toyota CNG
dealer before you dispose of your vehicle.
cccliii
Refueling station information
For information on refueling stations for CNG, contact
Natural Gas Vehicle Coalition (NGVC) at the address
and numbers listed below.
Natural Gas Vehicle Coalition
1515 Wilson Blvd.
Arlington, Va. 22209
Phone: (703) 527–3022
cccliv
1
9
9
9
Scheduled
Maintenance
Everyda
y
Guide
People
Table of Contents
INTRODUCTION
The Importance of Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Maintenance and Toyota Warranty Coverage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
TOYOTA MAINTENANCE & REPAIR SUPPORT
Toyota Dealership Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Toyota Express Lube . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Genuine Toyota Parts and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Lifetime Guarantee Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
TrueStart™ Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Collision Repair Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Do- It-Yourself Products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Toyota Parts Centers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Toyota Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Service Agreements and Pre- Paid Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE LOGS
Determining Your Vehicle’s Maintenance Needs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Explanation of Maintenance Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Maintenance Log: Cars and Sienna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Maintenance Log: SUVs and Tacoma . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
1
The Importance of Scheduled Maintenance
egular maintenance is essential to obtaining the highest
level of performance, safety and reliability from your
Toyota. It can also enhance your vehicle’s resale value.
This booklet is designed to help you make sure your vehicle
receives proper and timely maintenance. It includes factoryrecommended maintenance guidelines along with information
on the extensive maintenance and repair support available
through Toyota and your dealership. You’ll also find space to
document your vehicle’s maintenance history.
R
In addition to scheduled maintenance, your Toyota requires
ongoing general maintenance which includes checking fluid
levels and making periodic visual inspections. These items
are explained under the “General Maintenance” heading in
the “Vehicle Maintenance and Care” section of the Owner’s
Manual. Be sure to follow these guidelines carefully to ensure
the most trouble- free operation of your vehicle.
2
INTRODUCTION
With proper maintenance and care, your vehicle will last
longer and deliver more dependable, economical performance.
Follow this booklet’s recommendations and you’ll enjoy maximum reliability and peace of mind from your Toyota for many
years to come.
Maintenance & Toyota Warranty Coverage
Maintaining your vehicle according to the recommendations in
this booklet is required to ensure that your warranty coverage
remains in force. You should keep detailed records of vehicle
maintenance, including date of service, mileage at time of service and a description of service and/or parts installation
performed. The Scheduled Maintenance Log in this booklet is
a good place to record this information. If you sell your vehicle,
be sure to give your maintenance records to the new owner.
Toyota will not deny a warranty claim solely because you do
not have records to show that you maintained your vehicle.
However, damage or failures caused by lack of proper maintenance are not covered under warranty.
Your dealer may recommend more frequent maintenance intervals
or more maintenance services than those listed in the Scheduled
Maintenance Log. These additional services are not required to
maintain your warranty coverage. Ask your dealer for an explanation of any recommended maintenance not included in the
Scheduled Maintenance Log.
For a complete description of Toyota warranty coverages,
see the booklet entitled 1999 Owner’s Warranty
Information in your vehicle’s glove box.
Maintenance and repair services may be performed by you or
by any automotive service provider you choose. Toyota will
not deny a warranty claim solely because you used a service
provider other than a Toyota dealership for maintenance and
repairs. However, damage or failures caused by improper maintenance or repairs are not covered under warranty.
INTRODUCTION
3
Toyota Dealership Service
To ensure that your vehicle receives first- quality service and
factory- authorized parts, Toyota recommends having maintenance performed by an authorized Toyota dealership.
Toyota dealership technicians are experts in the maintenance and
repair of Toyota vehicles. They stay current on the latest service
information through Toyota technical bulletins, service publications and training courses. Many are also certified through the
Toyota Certified Technician Program, which requires completion
of Toyota’s specialized, state- of- the- art training as well as rigorous
exams through both Toyota and the National Institute for
Automotive Service Excellence. Feel free to ask any Toyota
dealership to show you its technicians’ credentials.
You can be confident you’re getting the best possible service for
your vehicle when you take it to a Toyota dealership. Why trust
your investment to anything but a team of highly qualified
Toyota specialists?
4
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
Toyota Express Lube
With Toyota Express Lube, you get the convenience of a quicklube shop and the quality and expertise you count on when you
go to a Toyota dealership. You also get the Express Lube guarantee: a complete oil- and- filter change and 19- point inspection in
29 minutes or less, or the next one is free.
You never need an appointment to use Express Lube at a
Toyota dealership. Just follow the signs and drive up to the
Express Lube lane — you’ll be waited on promptly, and your
oil- and- filter change will be done while you wait. Express Lube
delivers outstanding value as well, since the service is priced
very competitively with franchised quick- lube centers.
More than 400 Toyota dealerships now offer Express Lube
service. Call (800) 331- 4331 for the Express Lube location
nearest you.
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
5
Genuine Toyota Parts & Accessories
To safeguard the quality, reliability and value of your vehicle,
Toyota recommends using only Genuine Toyota Parts for
maintenance and repairs. Like all Toyota products, Genuine
Toyota Parts are built to the highest standards of quality and
performance. They are also designed to fit your vehicle’s exact
specifications.
For all your maintenance and repair needs, insist on the quality
and peace of mind you only get with Genuine Toyota Parts.
Your Toyota dealership maintains an extensive inventory of
Genuine Toyota Parts to meet your vehicle service needs. And
because it is linked electronically to Toyota’s Parts Distribution
Centers, the dealership has quick access to any parts it may
not have in stock.
When installed by a Toyota dealership, Genuine Toyota Parts
are warranted for 12 months (regardless of mileage) or the
remainder of any applicable NewVehicle Limited Warranty,
whichever is longer. Selected Toyota replacement parts are
covered by a lifetime warranty (see page 8). Non- Genuine
Toyota Parts — and any damage or failures resulting from their
use — are not covered by any Toyota warranty.
6
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
Genuine Toyota Parts & Accessories
When you want to personalize your Toyota vehicle, be sure
to do it without sacrificing Toyota quality and performance.
How? By choosing Genuine Toyota Accessories.
VIP SECURITY SYSTEM RS3000
Only Genuine Toyota Accessories are designed and manufactured specifically for Toyota vehicles. In addition, they undergo
rigorous testing to ensure first- rate quality, precise fit and longterm durability. Aftermarket accessories don’t always meet
these same high standards.
The quality of Genuine Toyota Accessories is also backed by
the integrity of a Toyota warranty. Coverage is for 12 months
from date of purchase, regardless of mileage. If the accessory is
installed at the time of new- vehicle purchase, coverage is extended to 36 months/36,000 miles. See your dealer for details. And
remember that Genuine Toyota Accessories can only be purchased from an authorized Toyota dealership.
COROLLA
REAR SPOILER
& GOLD PACKAGE
CAMRY FOG LIGHTS
SIENNA
RUNNING BOARDS
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
7
Lifetime Guarantee Replacement Parts
Toyota’s confidence in its products and commitment to customer satisfaction are demonstrated by outstanding warranty
coverage — including a lifetime guarantee on replacement
mufflers, exhaust pipes, shock absorbers, struts and strut
cartridges. When purchased at and installed by a Toyota dealership, these Genuine Toyota Parts are guaranteed to the original
purchaser for the life of the vehicle. This includes coverage for
parts and labor.
Compare the guarantees offered on these parts by aftermarket
repair shops — many don’t offer the extensive coverage Toyota
does. And remember that only Genuine Toyota Parts are manufactured to your vehicle’s exact specifications. So don’t compromise; when replacement time comes, count on your Toyota
dealer for quality, performance and the peace of mind that
comes with a factory- backed lifetime guarantee.
Compare Lifetime
Guarantee Coverage
Toyota vs. Others
• Muffler
- Labor to replace
• Tail Pipe
- Labor to replace
• Exhaust Pipes
- Labor to replace
Toyota Others*
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
We Cover
The Muffler,
Pipes And
Labor Too!
Theirs
Ours
For complete details of the Toyota Lifetime Guarantee, see an authorized
Toyota dealer.
8
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
* Some muffler shops–read their fine print and compare.
TrueStart Batteries
whichever is longer. Following the free replacement period, warranty coverage is prorated based on the battery’s time in use. See
your Toyota dealer for more details.
The reputation for quality and reliability was likely a key
reason behind your decision to buy a Toyota. That overall
quality is present in each of the components of your car or
truck, including the battery. When it’s time for a replacement,
your Toyota dealer is the only place to find a batterywith the
power to start and operate your vehicle like new.
Don’t entrust your Toyota’s performance to anything less than
the best: Genuine Toyota TrueStart™ Batteries.
To maintain the original performance designed into your Toyota,
a replacement battery must meet Toyota’s specifications for
Cold Cranking Amps (CCA) and Reserve Capacity (RC).
RC, a specification often not met by aftermarket brands, supplies the power you need during high- demand conditions such
as driving in heavy traffic. RC is also what gives you the power
to operate electronic accessories with the engine off. By choosing a TrueStart,™ you can be confident your battery will meet
your needs, every day.
Warranty coverage is another important consideration when
selecting a replacement battery. TrueStart™ batteries feature a
free replacement period of 18 months (regardless of mileage)
or the remainder of the Toyota NewVehicle Limited Warranty,
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
9
Collision Repair Parts
Insist on Genuine Toyota Quality
If you’re involved in a collision, you want your vehicle to be
returned to its pre- accident condition when repaired. To maintain your Toyota’s value, it’s important to make sure it’s repaired
with Genuine Toyota Parts. Some repair shops and insurance
companies may suggest using imitation or used salvage parts
to save money. However, these parts do not meet Toyota’s high
standards for quality, fit and corrosion resistance. In addition,
imitation and used salvage parts are not covered by any Toyota
warranty (see box at right).
To maintain the appearance, performance and safety of your
Toyota, make sure only Genuine Toyota Parts are used for
collision repairs. Protect your investment — insist on Genuine
Toyota quality.
10
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
Toyota warranty coverage remains intact when vehicle
repairs are completed with Genuine Toyota Parts. Toyota
warranties do not cover imitation or used salvage parts or
any damage or failures caused by the use of such parts.
In Case of Accident, Be an Informed Owner
Toyota believes customers have the right to choose the types of
parts used in the repair of their vehicles. That’s why Toyota supports full disclosure by repair shops and insurance companies
regarding parts used for collision repair. The following information is provided to help you understand the differences in the
types of parts that could be used in the repair of your vehicle.
General Information
“Collision repair parts” or “replacement crash parts” are the parts
typically replaced during the repair of a vehicle that has been
damaged in a collision. These parts include exterior sheet metal
such as fenders, hoods, doors and related components; and plastic components such as bumper covers and lamp assemblies.
SUPPORT
Collision Repair Parts
Warranty Coverage
Warranties for collision repair parts are provided by the manufacturer or distributor of the parts. Warranty coverage varies.
Your insurance company or collision repair facility should provide you with written warranty statements for all parts used in
the repair of your vehicle.
Types of Collision Repair Parts
New Original-Equipment Manufacturer (OEM)
Parts that are made by the vehicle manufacturer or one of its
licensees and distributed through its normal channels. These
parts maintain the manufacturer’s vehicle warranty.
Recycled or Used Salvage
Used parts and assemblies that have been removed from another vehicle. There are no systems in place to regulate the quality
or safety of these parts.
Remanufactured
Parts that have been returned to like- new condition through
repair, refurbishing or rebuilding.
Due to the critical nature of Supplemental Restraint
Systems (also known as air bags), Toyota does not support
the use of imitation or used parts for their repair. Only new
Genuine Toyota Parts should be used to repair/replace
Supplemental Restraint Systems.
Aftermarket or Imitation
Parts that are made by companies other than the vehicle manufacturer or its licensees.
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
11
Do-It-Yourself Products
When it’s time to replace key wear items on your vehicle, don’t
settle for less than Genuine Toyota Parts. Available exclusively
through Toyota dealerships, Genuine Toyota Parts meet the
highest standards of quality and performance and are built to
exact factory specifications. Here are a few of your vehicle’s
components that are particularly subject to wear and some
benefits of replacing them with Genuine Toyota Parts.
Genuine Toyota Platinum Spark Plugs *
• Designed to last at least 60,000 miles.
• Provide the maximum spark required by Toyota’s highcompression engines.
• Resist fouling and misfires for more efficient combustion
and better fuel economy.
Genuine Toyota Brake Pads
• Friction materials selected for optimum performance when
matched with Toyota brake drums or rotors.
• Precision- machined backing plates allow pads to move freely
within the calipers for smooth, efficient braking.
Genuine Toyota Wiper Inserts
• Cut to match the exact length and shape of your vehicle’s
wiper blades for a proper and secure fit.
• Constructed of compression- molded natural rubber — not
synthetic — for superior wiping performance.
* Available for selected models. See your dealer for details.
12
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
Do-It-Yourself Products
Genuine Toyota Chemicals
Genuine Toyota Motor Oil
Toyota offers a complete line of products to help you keep
your Toyota looking and running like new. To safeguard your
vehicle’s appearance, you’ll find everything from fabric spot
remover and glass cleaner to liquid car wash and touch- up paint.
When it’s time to get under the hood (or under the car), products
such as fuel injector cleaner, brake fluid and silicone spraywill
help you get the job done. All of these products are formulated
specifically for use with Toyota vehicles, so you can be confident
you’re giving your vehicle the best care possible, inside and out.
Your Toyota’s engine features highly advanced technology
to ensure superior performance, reliability and fuel economy.
Genuine Toyota Motor Oil is formulated with a special combination of lube- base stocks and an additive blend to maximize
the benefits of this technology. Make sure you’re getting the
most out of your engine by always putting the best into it:
Genuine Toyota Motor Oil.
Genuine Toyota Antifreeze Coolant
Genuine Toyota Long Life Antifreeze Coolant is the same
high quality, factory- fill product found in all new Toyotas. You’ll
know it by its distinctive red color. It provides maximum protection and durability without the use of harmful silicates. And
because it’s compatible with non- metallic materials, it helps
extend the life of water- pump seals. Don’t trust your engine
to anything less than the best: Genuine Toyota Long Life
Antifreeze Coolant.
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
13
Toyota Parts Centers
If you plan to perform your own maintenance or repairs on your
Toyota, be sure to check out your nearby Toyota Parts Center
(TPC). More than 475 Toyota dealerships now have a TPC,
which is an in- dealership parts store offering a wide selection
of automotive products. All TPCs feature a complete line of
Genuine Toyota maintenance parts and car- care products for
“do- it- yourselfers.”
In addition to Toyota maintenance and repair products, TPCs
offer free technical advice to Toyota owners who want to service
their own vehicles. You’ll also find model- specific parts application guides and how- to brochures covering most common
maintenance jobs. Both are provided to customers free of charge.
Toyota Parts Centers are open during regular dealership hours;
many also have extended evening and weekend hours. If you’re
a do- it- yourselfer, stop by and experience the service, selection
and value offered by your local TPC.
14
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
Toyota Service Manuals
If you’ll be doing some of your own maintenance and repair work
on your vehicle, a Toyota service manual will be one of your most
valuable tools. Toyota offers three types of manuals to assist
do- it- yourselfers. To order any of the following manuals, call
Toyota’s service publications department at (800) 622- 2033.
For information on basic do- it- yourself maintenance items,
see the “General Maintenance and Care” and “Do- ItYourself Maintenance” sections of your Owner’s Manual.
Vehicle Repair Manual
This is the same manual used by professional technicians in Toyota
dealerships throughout the United States. It is fully illustrated and
includes maintenance and repair procedures for all vehicle mechanical systems. It also includes instructions for vehicle tune- ups.
Electrical Systems Manual
This manual provides detailed wiring diagrams for each electrical system in your vehicle, along with troubleshooting tips and
repair procedures.
Automatic Transmission/Transaxle Repair Manual
This manual includes complete procedures for overhauling the
automatic transmission/transaxle of your vehicle.
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
SUPPORT
15
Service Agreements & Pre-Paid Maintenance
Vehicle Service Agreements
By covering the cost of repairs that are no longer covered by
warranty, a vehicle service agreement protects you from unexpected repair costs down the road. Many service agreements
also cover services such as towing and car rental that minimize
the inconvenience of a mechanical breakdown.
Through Genuine Toyota Financial Services, Toyota offers
service agreement plans to meet the needs of almost every
customer. Under these plans, repairs are made only by authorized Toyota dealerships using Genuine Toyota Parts. This
means you always get original- equipment quality installed
by factory- trained technicians.
Your Toyota dealer can help you select the service agreement
plan that’s best for you. Be sure to request a plan from Genuine
Toyota Financial Services to get the highest level of quality,
service and peace of mind.
16
TOYOTA
MAINTENANCE
&
R E PA I R
Pre-Paid Maintenance
An excellent way to ensure that your Toyota receives regular
maintenance — and to protect yourself from increases in vehicle
service costs — is to pay for maintenance services in advance.
Toyota offers pre- paid maintenance plans for both new and
used vehicles. Both plans cover oil- and- filter changes, lubrication of key chassis parts and a 19- point vehicle inspection. The
plans also include 24- hour roadside assistance, timed service
reminders and a computerized history of each service visit.
To meet differing customer needs, Toyota’s pre- paid maintenance plans offer a variety of options for service intervals and
coverage length. Ask your Toyota dealer to help you select the
options that are best for you.
SUPPORT
Determining Your Vehicle’s Maintenance Needs
Determining the Proper
Maintenance Interval
Depending on your circumstances, you should obtain maintenance for your Toyota every 5,000 miles or every 7, 500 miles.
Follow these guidelines to determine which interval to use.
5,000-Mile Intervals
Use 5,000- mile intervals if you primarily operate your vehicle
under any of the following conditions:
• Driving on unpaved or dusty roads.
• Towing a trailer or using a camper or car- top carrier.
• Repeated trips of less than five miles in temperatures
below freezing.
7,500-Mile Intervals
Use 7, 500- mile intervals if you primarily operate your vehicle
under conditions other than those listed above.
Following the Maintenance Log Charts
The Scheduled Maintenance Log identifies the maintenance
required at each mileage interval and corresponding time interval
based on mileage of 1, 250 miles per month. If you drive more than
1, 250 miles per month, you should obtain maintenance at the indicated mileage interval rather than the indicated time interval.
If you choose 5,000- mile intervals, follow the maintenance
instructions shown below non- shaded headings such as this one:
5,000 Miles or 4 Months
If you choose 7, 500- mile intervals, follow the maintenance
instructions shown below shaded headings such as this one:
7, 500 Miles or 6 Months
At 15,000- mile increments, the 5,000- mile and 7, 500- mile
intervals coincide. Therefore, shaded and non- shaded headings
appear together, as in this example:
15,000 Miles or 12 Months
15,000 Miles or 12 Months
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
17
Determining Your Vehicle’s Maintenance Needs
Special Operating Conditions
In addition to standard maintenance items, the Scheduled
Maintenance Log indicates services that should be performed
on vehicles that are driven under especially demanding conditions. Specific conditions require specific services, as indicated
below. The Scheduled Maintenance Log indicates at which
mileage/time intervals each service should be performed.
• Inspect steering linkage
• Re- torque drive shaft flange bolts*
• Lubricate propeller shaft and re- torque bolts*
You should perform these additional maintenance services if
you drive primarily under any of the conditions noted. If you
drive only occasionally under these conditions, it is not necessary to perform the additional services.
• Inspect brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
• Inspect or change engine air filter
• Lubricate propeller shaft and re- torque bolts *
Driving on Rough, Muddy or Snow-Melted Roads
Extensive Idling or Low-Speed Driving
for Long Distances
•
•
•
•
•
Rotate tires
Inspect ball joints and dust cover
Inspect brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
Inspect drive shaft boots
Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
Driving on Salt-Covered Roads
• Lubricate propeller shaft and re- torque bolts*
Driving on Unpaved or Dusty Roads
• Inspect brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
* Applies to selected models. See the Scheduled Maintenance Log for details.
18
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
Determining Your Vehicle’s Maintenance Needs
Towing a Trailer or Using a Camper
or Car-Top Carrier
•
•
•
•
•
•
Inspect brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
Replace differential oil
Replace transmission fluid or oil
Replace transfer oil*
Lubricate propeller shaft and re- torque bolts*
Off-Road Maintenance
If you own a Land Cruiser or a four- wheel drive RAV4,
Tacoma or 4Runner, you should check the following items
daily whenever you drive off- road through deep sand, mud
or water:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Brake lines and hoses
Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
Engine air filter
Differential oil
Steering linkage
Transfer oil
Transmission fluid or oil
Wheel bearings
For all four- wheel drive vehicles except RAV4, you should
also lubricate the propeller shafts daily.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
19
Explanation of Maintenance Items
The following descriptions are provided to give you a better
understanding of the maintenance items that should be performed on your vehicle. The Scheduled Maintenance Log
indicates at which mileage/time intervals each item should be
performed. Please note that many maintenance items should be
performed only by a qualified technician.
For further information on maintenance items you can perform yourself, see the “General Maintenance and Care” and
“Do- It-Yourself Maintenance” sections ofyour Owner’s Manual.
Automatic Transmission Fluid
or Manual Transmission Oil
Inspect each component for signs of leakage. If you discover any
leakage, have it repaired by a qualified technician immediately.
Ball Joints and Dust Covers
Check the suspension and steering linkage ball joints for looseness and damage. Check all dust covers for deterioration and
damage. A qualified technician should perform these inspections.
Brake Lines and Hoses
Visually inspect for proper installation. Check for chafing,
cracks, deterioration and evidence of leaking. Replace any deteriorated or damaged parts immediately. A qualified technician
should perform these operations.
20
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
Explanation of Maintenance Items
Brake Linings/Drums and Brake Pads/Discs
Drive Shaft Boots
Check the brake linings (shoes) and drums for scoring, burning,
fluid leakage, broken parts and excessive wear. Check the pads for
excessive wear and the discs for runout, excessive wear and fluid
leakage. A qualified technician should perform these inspections.
Check the drive shaft boots and clamps for cracks, deterioration and damage. Replace any damaged parts and, if necessary,
repack the grease. Selected models also require periodic inspection of the flange bolts for proper torque. A qualified technician
should perform these operations.
Charcoal Canister (CA, MA and NY vehicles)
Check for internal damage and clogging. If necessary, clean
with compressed air or replace. A qualified technician should
perform these operations.
Engine Air Filter
Check for damage, excessive wear and oiliness. Replace if necessary.
Engine Coolant
Differential Oil
Inspect each component for signs of leakage. If you discover any
leakage, have it repaired by a qualified technician immediately.
Drain and flush the cooling system and refill with an ethyleneglycol type coolant. A qualified technician should perform
this operation.
Drive Belts
Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Inspect for cracks, excessive wear and oiliness. Check the belt tension and adjust if necessary. Replace the belts if they are damaged.
Change the oil filter and replace the engine oil with API SH,
Energy- Conserving II multigrade or ILSAC multigrade oil.
For recommended viscosity, refer to your Owner’s Manual.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
21
Explanation of Maintenance Items
22
Engine Valves
Nuts and Bolts on Chassis and Body
Inspect for excessive lifter noise and engine vibration and adjust if
necessary. A qualified technician should perform this operation.
Re- tighten the seat mounting bolts and front/rear suspension
member retaining bolts to specified torque.
Exhaust Pipes and Mountings
Propeller Shaft
Visually inspect the exhaust pipes, muffler and hangers for
cracks, deterioration and damage. Start the engine and listen
carefully for any exhaust gas leakage. Tighten connections or
replace parts as necessary.
Lubricate the propeller shaft spiders and slide yokes with
lithium- base chassis grease and the double cardan joint with
molybdenum- disulfide lithium- base chassis grease, and retorque the flange bolts. Only a qualified technician should
re- torque the flange bolts.
Fuel Lines and Connections, Fuel Tank Band
and Fuel Tank Vapor Vent System Hoses
Spark Plugs
Visually inspect for corrosion, damage, cracks and loose or leaking
connections. Tighten connections or replace parts as necessary.
Install new plugs of the same type as originally equipped. A
qualified technician should perform this operation.
Fuel Tank Cap Gasket
Steering Gear Box
Visually inspect for cracks, deterioration and damage and
replace if necessary.
Inspect for signs of leakage. If you discover any leakage, have it
repaired immediately by a qualified technician.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
Explanation of Maintenance Items
Steering Linkage
Wheel Bearing and Drive Shaft Bushing Grease
With the vehicle stopped, check for excessive freeplay in the steering wheel. Inspect the linkage for bending and damage and the dust
boots for deterioration, cracks and damage. Replace any damaged
parts. A qualified technician should perform these operations.
Repack the wheel bearings with wheel bearing grease and the
front drive shaft bushings with molybdenum- disulfide lithiumbase chassis grease. A qualified technician should perform
these operations.
Timing Belt
Replace every 90,000 miles. A qualified technician should perform this operation.
Tire Rotation
Tires should be rotated according to the instructions in the
Owner’s Manual. When rotating tires, check for damage and
uneven wear.
Transfer Case Oil
Inspect each component for signs of leakage. If you discover any
leakage, have it repaired by a qualified technician immediately.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
23
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
5,000 Miles or 4 Months
10,000 Miles or 8 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
7,500 Miles or 6 Months
24
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
15,000 Miles or 12 Months
15,000 Miles or 12 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Automatic transmission fluid
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Differential oil
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect engine air filter
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
❑ Replace automatic transmission fluid
❑ Replace differential oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
25
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
20,000 Miles or 16 Months
25,000 Miles or 20 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
22,500 Miles or 18 Months
26
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
30,000 Miles or 24 Months
30,000 Miles or 24 Months
❑ Replace engine air filter
❑ Replace engine coolant
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Replace non-platinum spark plugs (Corolla, Paseo, Tercel)1
❑ Repack front wheel bearings (Paseo, Tercel)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts (non-ribbed)
__ Fuel lines and connections, fuel tank band
and fuel tank vapor vent system hoses
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Fuel tank cap gasket
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
__ Transmission fluid or oil
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on body and chassis
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace transmission fluid or oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
1
Required under the terms of the Emission Control Warranty.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
27
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
35,000 Miles or 28 Months
40,000 Miles or 32 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
37,500 Miles or 30 Months
28
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
45,000 Miles or 36 Months
45,000 Miles or 36 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Automatic transmission fluid
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Differential oil
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect engine air filter
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace automatic transmission fluid
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
29
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
50,000 Miles or 40 Months
55,000 Miles or 44 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
52,500 Miles or 42 Months
30
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
60,000 Miles or 48 Months
60,000 Miles or 48 Months
❑ Replace engine air filter
❑ Replace engine coolant
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Replace platinum spark plugs1
❑ Replace non-platinum spark plugs (Corolla, Paseo, Tercel)1
❑ Repack front wheel bearings (Paseo, Tercel)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Charcoal canister2
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts
__ Fuel lines and connections, fuel tank band
and fuel tank vapor vent system hoses
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine valves
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Fuel tank cap gasket
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
__ Transmission fluid or oil
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on body and chassis
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace transmission fluid or oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
1
Required under the terms of the Emission Control Warranty.
2
Inspect at 60,000 miles or 72 months, whichever comes first, for Avalon, 6-cyl. Camry,
6-cyl. Camry Solara, Paseo, Sienna and Tercel. Required only for vehicles in California,
Massachusetts and New York.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
31
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
65,000 Miles or 52 Months
70,000 Miles or 56 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
67,500 Miles or 54 Months
32
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
75,000 Miles or 60 Months
75,000 Miles or 60 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Automatic transmission fluid
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect engine air filter
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace automatic transmission fluid
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
33
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
80,000 Miles or 64 Months
85,000 Miles or 68 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
82,500 Miles or 66 Months
34
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
90,000 Miles or 72 Months
90,000 Miles or 72 Months
❑ Replace engine air filter
❑ Replace engine coolant
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Replace non-platinum spark plugs (Corolla, Paseo, Tercel)1
❑ Repack front wheel bearings (Paseo, Tercel)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Replace timing belt (except Corolla)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts (non-ribbed)
__ Fuel lines and connections, fuel tank band
and fuel tank vapor vent system hoses
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Fuel tank cap gasket
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
__ Transmission fluid or oil
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on body and chassis
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace transmission fluid or oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
1
Required under the terms of the Emission Control Warranty.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
35
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
95,000 Miles or 76 Months
100,000 Miles or 80 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
97,500 Miles or 78 Months
36
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
105,000 Miles or 84 Months
105,000 Miles or 84 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Automatic transmission fluid
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect engine air filter
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace automatic transmission fluid
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
37
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
110,000 Miles or 88 Months
115,000 Miles or 92 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
112,500 Miles or 90 Months*
38
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. Cars & Sienna
120,000 Miles or 96 Months
120 Months
120,000 Miles or 96 Months
120 Months
❑ Replace engine air filter
❑ Replace engine coolant
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Replace platinum spark plugs1
❑ Replace non-platinum spark plugs (Corolla, Paseo, Tercel)1
❑ Repack front wheel bearings (Paseo, Tercel)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (Sienna)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Charcoal canister2
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts
__ Fuel lines and connections, fuel tank band
and fuel tank vapor vent system hoses
❑ Inspect SRS Air Bag
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine valves
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Fuel tank cap gasket
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
__ Transmission fluid or oil
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on body and chassis
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace transmission fluid or oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
1
Required under the terms of the Emission Control Warranty.
2
Inspect at 120,000 miles or 144 months, whichever comes first, for Avalon, 6-cyl. Camry,
6-cyl. Camry Solara, Paseo, Sienna and Tercel. Required only for vehicles in California,
Massachusetts and New York.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
39
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
5,000 Miles or 4 Months
10,000 Miles or 8 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
7,500 Miles or 6 Months
SCHEDULED
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
Mileage:
40
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
15,000 Miles or 12 Months
15,000 Miles or 12 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Automatic transmission fluid
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Limited-slip differential oil
(Land Cruiser, 4WD RAV4)1
__ Differential oil
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect engine air filter
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
❑ Replace automatic transmission fluid
❑ Replace differential oil (including limited-slip)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
1
If vehicle is equipped with limited-slip differential.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
41
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
20,000 Miles or 16 Months
25,000 Miles or 20 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
22,500 Miles or 18 Months
SCHEDULED
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
Mileage:
42
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
30,000 Miles or 24 Months
30,000 Miles or 24 Months
❑ Replace engine air filter
❑ Replace engine coolant
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Replace limited-slip differential oil (Land Cruiser)1
❑ Replace non-platinum spark plugs (Tacoma, 4Runner)2
❑ Repack front wheel bearings (Tacoma 2WD)
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Lubricate drive shaft bushings (4WD Tacoma without ADD)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts (non-ribbed)
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Fuel lines and connections, fuel tank band
and fuel tank vapor vent system hoses
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Fuel tank cap gasket
__ Limited-slip differential oil (4WD RAV4)1
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
__ Transfer case oil (4WD models)
__ Transmission fluid or oil
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on body and chassis
❑ Replace differential oil (including limited-slip)
❑ Replace transfer case oil (4WD models)
❑ Replace transmission fluid or oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
1
If vehicle is equipped with limited-slip differential.
2
Required under the terms of the Emission Control Warranty.
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
43
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
35,000 Miles or 28 Months
40,000 Miles or 32 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
37,500 Miles or 30 Months
SCHEDULED
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
Mileage:
44
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
45,000 Miles or 36 Months
45,000 Miles or 36 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Automatic transmission fluid
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Limited-slip differential oil
(Land Cruiser, 4WD RAV4)1
__ Differential oil
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect engine air filter
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
❑ Replace automatic transmission fluid
❑ Replace differential oil (including limited-slip)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
1
If vehicle is equipped with limited-slip differential.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
45
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
50,000 Miles or 40 Months
55,000 Miles or 44 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
52,500 Miles or 42 Months
SCHEDULED
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
Mileage:
46
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
60,000 Miles or 48 Months
60,000 Miles or 48 Months
❑ Replace engine air filter
❑ Replace engine coolant
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Replace limited-slip differential oil (Land Cruiser, RAV4 4WD)1
❑ Replace platinum spark plugs (RAV4)2
❑ Replace non-platinum spark plugs (Tacoma, 4Runner)2
❑ Repack front wheel bearings (Tacoma 2WD)
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Lubricate drive shaft bushings (4WD Tacoma without ADD)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Charcoal canister 3
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts
__ Fuel lines and connections, fuel tank band
and fuel tank vapor vent system hoses
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine valves
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Fuel tank cap gasket
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
__ Transfer case oil (4WD models)
__ Transmission fluid or oil
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on body and chassis
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace transfer case oil (4WD models)
❑ Replace transmission fluid or oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
1
If vehicle is equipped with limited-slip differential.
2
Required under the terms of the Emission Control Warranty.
3
Inspect at 60,000 miles or 72 months, whichever comes first.
Required only for vehicles in California, Massachusetts and New York.
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
47
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
65,000 Miles or 52 Months
70,000 Miles or 56 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
67,500 Miles or 54 Months
SCHEDULED
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
Mileage:
48
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
75,000 Miles or 60 Months
75,000 Miles or 60 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Automatic transmission fluid
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Limited-slip differential oil
(Land Cruiser, 4WD RAV4)1
__ Differential oil
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect engine air filter
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
❑ Replace automatic transmission fluid
❑ Replace differential oil (including limited-slip)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
1
If vehicle is equipped with limited-slip differential.
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
49
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
80,000 Miles or 64 Months
85,000 Miles or 68 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
82,500 Miles or 66 Months
SCHEDULED
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
Mileage:
50
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
90,000 Miles or 72 Months
90,000 Miles or 72 Months
❑ Replace engine air filter
❑ Replace engine coolant
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Replace limited-slip differential oil (Land Cruiser)1
❑ Replace iridium spark plugs (Land Cruiser)2
❑ Replace non-platinum spark plugs (Tacoma, 4Runner)2
❑ Replace timing belt (except 4-cyl. Tacoma and 4Runner)
❑ Repack front wheel bearings (Tacoma 2WD)
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Lubricate drive shaft bushings (4WD Tacoma without ADD)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Fuel lines and connections, fuel tank band
and fuel tank vapor vent system hoses
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Fuel tank cap gasket
__ Limited-slip differential oil (4WD RAV4)1
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
__ Transfer case oil (4WD models)
__ Transmission fluid or oil
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on body and chassis
❑ Replace differential oil (including limited-slip)
❑ Replace transfer case oil (4WD models)
❑ Replace transmission fluid or oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
1
If vehicle is equipped with limited-slip differential.
2
Required under the terms of the Emission Control Warranty.
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
51
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
95,000 Miles or 76 Months
100,000 Miles or 80 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
97,500 Miles or 78 Months
SCHEDULED
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
Mileage:
52
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
105,000 Miles or 84 Months
105,000 Miles or 84 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Automatic transmission fluid
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Limited-slip differential oil
(Land Cruiser, 4WD RAV4)1
__ Differential oil
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect engine air filter
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on chassis and body
❑ Replace automatic transmission fluid
❑ Replace differential oil (including limited-slip)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
53
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
5,000-Mile Maintenance Intervals
7,500-Mile Maintenance Intervals
110,000 Miles or 88 Months
115,000 Miles or 92 Months
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Drive shaft boots
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date:
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
Date:
❑ Rotate tires
Mileage:
* Specific services apply to specific operating conditions. See pages 18–19 for details.
MAINTENANCE
Date:
Mileage:
112,500 Miles or 90 Months*
SCHEDULED
__ Engine air filter
__ Nuts and bolts on chassis and body
__ Steering linkage
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
Mileage:
54
To determine the appropriate
maintenance interval for your vehicle,
see page 17.
LOGS
Maintenance Log. SUVs & Tacoma
120,000 Miles or 96 Months
120 Months
120,000 Miles or 96 Months
120 Months
❑ Replace engine air filter
❑ Replace engine coolant
❑ Replace engine oil and oil filter
❑ Rotate tires
❑ Replace limited-slip differential oil (Land Cruiser, RAV4 4WD)1
❑ Replace platinum spark plugs (RAV4)2
❑ Replace non-platinum spark plugs (Tacoma, 4Runner)2
❑ Repack front wheel bearings (Tacoma 2WD)
❑ Lubricate propeller shaft and re-torque bolts (all 4WD except RAV4)
❑ Lubricate drive shaft bushings (4WD Tacoma without ADD)
❑ Re-torque drive shaft flange bolts (all 4WD except Land Cruiser)
❑ Inspect the following:
__ Ball joints and dust covers
__ Brake lines and hoses
__ Brake linings/drums and brake pads/discs
__ Charcoal canister 3
__ Differential oil
__ Drive belts
__ Drive shaft boots
__ Fuel lines and connections, fuel tank band
and fuel tank vapor vent system hoses
❑ Inspect SRS Air Bag
Date: __________________
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Mileage: _______________
__ Engine valves
__ Exhaust pipes and mountings
__ Fuel tank cap gasket
__ Steering gear box
__ Steering linkage
__ Transfer case oil (4WD models)
__ Transmission fluid or oil
Additional Maintenance Items for Special Operating Conditions:*
❑ Inspect nuts and bolts on body and chassis
❑ Replace differential oil
❑ Replace transfer case oil (4WD models)
❑ Replace transmission fluid or oil
DEALER SERVICE VERIFICATION
Date: __________________
1
If vehicle is equipped with limited-slip differential.
2
Required under the terms of the Emission Control Warranty.
3
Inspect at 120,000 miles or 144 months, whichever comes first.
Required only for vehicles in California, Massachusetts and New York.
Mileage: _______________
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
55
Vehicle Identification
Model
Mileage at delivery
Body style
Key number
Model year
Selling dealership
In-service date
Selling dealership phone number
Vehicle identification number
56
SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE
LOGS
w w w .t o y o ta .c o m
00400-01999-SMG1
Printed in U.S.A.
6/98
SS–1
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STANDARD BOLT
STANDARD BOLT
SS0ZS–01
HOW TO DETERMINE BOLT STRENGTH
Bolt Type
Hexagon Head Bolt
Normal Recess Bolt
Deep Recess Bolt
Stud Bolt
Weld Bolt
4
Class
4T
No Mark
No Mark
No Mark
5
5T
6
6T
w/ Washer
w/ Washer
7
7T
8
8T
9
9T
10
10T
11
11T
B06431
Author:
Date:
164
SS–2
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STANDARD BOLT
SS0ZT–01
SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR STANDARD BOLTS
Specified torque
Class
Diameter
mm
Pitch
mm
Hexagon head bolt
Hexagon flange bolt
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
4T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
5
12.5
26
47
74
115
55
130
260
480
760
1,150
48 in.·lbf
9
19
35
55
83
6
14
29
53
84
–
60
145
290
540
850
–
52 in.·lbf
10
21
39
61
–
5T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
6.5
15.5
32
59
91
140
65
160
330
600
930
1,400
56 in.·lbf
12
24
43
67
101
7.5
17.5
36
65
100
–
75
175
360
670
1,050
–
65 in.·lbf
13
26
48
76
–
6T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
8
19
39
71
110
170
80
195
400
730
1,100
1,750
69 in.·lbf
14
29
53
80
127
9
21
44
80
125
–
90
210
440
810
1,250
–
78 in.·lbf
15
32
59
90
–
7T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
10.5
25
52
95
145
230
110
260
530
970
1,500
2,300
8
19
38
70
108
166
12
28
58
105
165
–
120
290
590
1,050
1,700
–
9
21
43
76
123
–
8T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
29
61
110
300
620
1,100
22
45
80
33
68
120
330
690
1,250
24
50
90
9T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
34
70
125
340
710
1,300
25
51
94
37
78
140
380
790
1,450
27
57
105
10T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
38
78
140
390
800
1,450
28
58
105
42
88
155
430
890
1,600
31
64
116
11T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
42
87
155
430
890
1,600
31
64
116
47
97
175
480
990
1,800
35
72
130
Author:
Date:
165
SS–3
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STANDARD BOLT
SS0ZU–01
HOW TO DETERMINE NUT STRENGTH
Nut Type
Present Standard
Hexagon Nut
Old Standard Hexagon Nut
Cold Forging Nut
Class
Cutting Processed Nut
4N
No Mark
5N (4T)
No Mark (w/ Washer)
No Mark (w/ Washer)
No Mark
6N
6N
7N (5T)
*
8N
8N
10N (7T)
10N
No Mark
11N
11N
12N
12N
*: Nut with 1 or more marks on one side surface of the nut.
B06432
HINT:
Use the nut with the same number of the nut strength classification or the greater than the bolt strength classification number when tightening parts with a bolt and nut.
Example: Bolt = 4T
Nut = 4N or more
Author:
Date:
166
SS–4
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MAINTENANCE
MAINTENANCE
SS074–01
SERVICE DATA
Front axle and suspension
Ball joint vertical play
Maximum 0 mm (0 in.)
Author:
Date:
167
SS–5
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MAINTENANCE
SS075–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Front seat mount bolts
37
375
27
Front suspension member x Body
181
1,850
134
Rear suspension member x Body
51
520
38
Author:
Date:
168
SS–6
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
SS0AD–03
SERVICE DATA
Compression
pressure
at 250 rpm STD 1,226 kPa (12.5 kgf/cm2, 178 psi) or more
Minimum 981 kPa (10.0 kgf/cm2, 142 psi)
Difference of pressure between each cylinder
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi) or less
Valve
clearance
Adjusting shim (for repair part)
Ignition timing
w/ Terminals TE1 and E1 connected of DLC1
Idle speed
Free length
Installed load at 50.5 mm (1.988 in.)
Cylinder head
Warpage
Cylinder block side
Manifold side
Valve seat
Refacing angle
Contacting angle
Contacting width
Valve guide
bushing
Inside diameter
Outside diameter (for repair part)
Valve
Valve overall length
Vale face angle
Stem diameter
Stem oil clearance
Margin thickness
Deviation
Free length
Installed tension at 34.7 mm (1.366 in.)
0.19 – 0.29 mm (0.007 – 0.011 in.)
0.28 – 0.38 mm (0.011 – 0.015 in.)
2.500 mm (0.0984 in.)
2.550 mm (0.1004 in.)
2.600 mm (0.1024 in.)
2.650 mm (0.1043 in.)
2.700 mm (0.1063 in.)
2.750 mm (0.1083 in.)
2.800 mm (0.1102 in.)
2.850 mm (0.1122 in.)
2.900 mm (0.1142 in.)
2.950 mm (0.1161 in.)
3.000 mm (0.1181 in.)
3.050 mm (0.1201 in.)
3.100 mm (0.1220 in.)
3.150 mm (0.1240 in.)
3.200 mm (0.1260 in.)
3.250 mm (0.1280 in.)
3.300 mm (0.1299 in.)
8 – 12° BTDC @ idle
700 ± 50 rpm
–
Idler pulley
tension spring
Valve spring
at cold Intake
Exhaust
Mark 2.500
Mark 2.550
Mark 2.600
Mark 2.650
Mark 2.700
Mark 2.750
Mark 2.800
Mark 2.850
Mark 2.900
Mark 2.950
Mark 3.000
Mark 3.050
Mark 3.100
Mark 3.150
Mark 3.200
Mark 3.250
Mark 3.300
42.0 mm (1.654 in.)
32 – 37 N (3.25 – 3.75 kgf, 7.2 – 8.3 lbf)
Maximum 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Maximum 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
30°, 45°, 75°
45°
1.0 – 1.4 mm (0.039 – 0.055 in.)
STD
O/S 0.05
6.010 – 6.030 mm (0.2366 – 0.2374 in.)
11.048 – 11.059 mm (0.4331 – 0.4342 in.)
11.050 – 11.077 mm (0.4350 – 0.4361 in.)
STD Intake
Exhaust
Minimum Intake
Exhaust
97.40 – 97.80 mm (3.8346 – 3.8504 in.)
98.25 – 98.65 mm (3.8681 – 3.8839 in.)
97.1 mm (3.823 in.)
98.0 mm (3.858 in.)
44.5°
Intake 5.970 – 5.985 mm (0.2350 – 0.2356 in.)
Exhaust
E
h
t 5.965
5 965 – 5.980
5 980 mm (0.2348
(0 2348 – 0.2354
0 2354 in.)
i )
STD Intake 0.025 – 0.060 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust 0.030 – 0.065 mm (0.0012 – 0.0026 in.)
Maximum Intake 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
STD 0.8 – 1.2 mm (0.031 – 0.047 in.)
Minimum 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
Maximum 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
40.95 – 42.80 mm (1.6122 – 1.6850 in.)
164 – 189 N (16.7 – 19.3 kgf, 36.8 – 42.5 lbf)
Author:
Date:
169
SS–7
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
Valve lifter
Lifter diameter
Lifter bore diameter
Oil clearance
30.966 – 30.976 mm (1.2191 – 1.2195 in.)
31.000 – 31.018 mm (1.2205 – 1.2212 in.)
STD 0.024 – 0.052 mm (0.0009 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Manifold
Warpage
Maximum 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
Camshaft
Thrust clearance
Journal oil clearance
Journal diameter
Circle runout
Cam lobe height
Camshaft gear backlash
Camshaft gear spring end free distance
STD Intake
Exhaust
Maximum Intake
Exhaust
STD
Maximum
0.045 – 0.100 mm (0.0018 – 0.0039 in.)
0.030 – 0.085 mm (0.0012 – 0.0033 in.)
0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
0.025 – 0.062 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
26.959 – 26.975 mm (1.0614 – 1.0620 in.)
Maximum 0.04 mm (0.0016 in.)
STD Intake 42.01 – 42.11 mm (1.6539 – 1.6579 in.)
Exhaust 40.06 – 40.16 mm (1.5772 – 1.5811 in.)
Minimum Intake 41.90 mm (1.6496 in.)
Exhaust 39.95 mm (1.5728 in.)
STD 0.020 – 0.200 mm (0.0008 – 0.0079 in.)
Maximum 0.30 mm (0.0188 in.)
22.5 – 22.9 mm (0.886 – 0.902 in.)
Cylinder block
Cylinder head surface warpage
Cylinder bore diameter
Maximum
STD Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Maximum STD
O/S 0.50
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
87.000 – 87.010 mm (3.4252 – 3.4256 in.)
87.010 – 87.020 mm (3.4256 – 3.4260 in.)
87.020 – 87.030 mm (3.4260 – 3.4264 in.)
87.23 mm (3.4342 in.)
87.73 mm (3.4350 in.)
Piston and
piston ring
Piston diameter
STD Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
O/S 0.50
STD
Maximum
No.1, No.2
STD No.1
No.2
Oil (side rail)
Maximum No.1
No.2
Oil (side rail)
86.815 – 86.825 mm (3.4179 – 3.4183 in.)
86.825 – 86.835 mm (3.4183 – 3.4186 in.)
86.835 – 86.845 mm (3.4201 – 3.4205 in.)
87.350 – 87.380 mm (3.4375 – 3.4387 in.)
0.175 – 0.195 mm (0.0068 – 0.0076 in.)
0.215 mm (0.0085 in.)
0.030 – 0.070 mm (0.0012 – 0.0028 in.)
0.270 – 0.490 mm (0.0106 – 0.0192 in.)
0.450 – 0.670 mm (0.0177 – 0.0263 in.)
0.100 – 0.470 mm (0.0039 – 0.0185 in.)
1.09 mm (0.0429 in.)
1.27 mm (0.0499 in.)
1.07 mm (0.0421in.)
Piston oil clearance
Piston ring groove clearance
Piston ring end gap
Connecting rod
Thrust clearance
STD 0.160 – 0.312 mm (0.0063 – 0.0123 inb.)
Maximum 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
Connecting rod bearing center wall thickness
Reference
STD Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Connecting rod oil clearance
STD STD
U/S 0.25
Maximum
Rod bend
Maximum per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Rod twist
Maximum per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Bushing inside diameter
Piston pin diameter
Piston pin oil clearance
STD
Maximum
Connecting rod bolt outside diameter
STD
Minimum
1.484 – 1.488 mm (0.0584 – 0.0586 in.)
1.488 – 1.492 mm (0.0586 – 0.0587 in.)
1.492 – 1.496 mm (0.0587 – 0.0589 in.)
0.024 – 0.055 mm (0.0009 – 0.0022 in.)
0.023 – 0.069 mm (0.0009 – 0.0027 in.)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
22.005 – 22.017 mm (0.8663 – 0.8668 in.)
21.997 – 22.009 mm (0.8660 – 0.8665 in.)
0.005 – 0.011 mm (0.0002 – 0.0004 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
7.860 – 8.000 mm (0.3094 – 0.3150 in.)
7.60 mm (0.2992 in.)
Author:
Date:
170
SS–8
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
Crankshaft
Thrust clearance
STD 0.020 – 0.220 mm (0.0008 – 0.0087 in.)
Maximum 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
Thrust washer thickness
2.440 – 2.490 mm (0.0961 – 0.0980 in.)
Main journal oil clearance
STD No.3 STD 0.025 – 0.044 mm (0.0010 – 0.0017 in.)
U/S 0.25 0.027 – 0.067 mm (0.0011 – 0.0026 in.)
Others STD 0.015 – 0.034 mm (0.0006 – 0.0013 in.)
U/S 0.25 0.019 – 0.059 mm (0.0007 – 0.0023 in.)
Maximum 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Main journal diameter
STD 54.988 – 55.003 mm (2.1653 – 2.1655 in.)
U/S 0.25 54.745 – 54.755 mm (2.1553 – 2.1557 in.)
Main bearing center wall thickness (Reference)
STD No.3 Mark 1 1.992 – 1.995 mm (0.0784 – 0.0785 in.)
Mark 2 1.995 – 1.998 mm (0.0785 – 0.0787 in.)
Mark 3 1.998 – 2.001 mm (0.0787 – 0.0788 in.)
Mark 4 2.001 – 2.004 mm (0.0788 – 0.0789 in.)
Mark 5 2.004 – 2.007 mm (0.0789 – 0.0790 in.)
Others Mark 1 1.997 – 2.000 mm (0.0786 – 0.0787 in.)
Mark 2 2.000 – 2.003 mm (0.0787 – 0.0789 in.)
Mark 3 2.003 – 2.006 mm (0.0789 – 0.0790 in.)
Mark 4 2.006 – 2.009 mm (0.0790 – 0.0791 in.)
Mark 5 2.009 – 2.012 mm (0.0791 – 0.0792 in.)
Crank pin diameter
STD 51.985 – 52.000 mm (2.0466 – 2.0472 in.)
U/S 0.25 51.745 – 51.755 mm (2.0372 – 2.0376 in.)
Circle runout
Maximum 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Main journal taper and out–of–round
Maximum 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Crank pin taper and out–of–round
Maximum 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Balance shaft
Thrust clearance
Backlash
Crankshaft to No.1 Balance shaft
Off–vehicle
On–vehicle
Adjusting spacer thickness
STD 0.060 – 0.110 mm (0.0024 – 0.0043 in.)
Maximum 0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
STD at punch mark A
at punch mark B
STD at punch mark A
at punch mark B
No.01
No.03
No.05
No.07
No.09
No.11
No.13
No.15
No.17
No.19
No.21
No.23
No.25
No.27
No.29
No.31
No.33
No.35
No.37
No.39
0.005 – 0.040 mm (0.002 – 0.0016 in.)
0.005 – 0.060 mm (0.002 – 0.0024 in.)
0.025 – 0.065 mm (0.0010 – 0.0026 in.)
0.025 – 0.085 mm (0.0010 – 0.0033 in.)
1.74 mm (0.0685 in.)
1.76 mm (0.0693 in.)
1.78 mm (0.0701 in.)
1.80 mm (0.0709 in.)
1.82 mm (0.0717 in.)
1.84 mm (0.0724 in.)
1.86 mm (0.0732 in.)
1.88 mm (0.0740 in.)
1.90 mm (0.0748 in.)
1.92 mm (0.0756 in.)
1.94 mm (0.0764 in.)
1.96 mm (0.0772 in.)
1.98 mm (0.0780 in.)
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
2.02 mm (0.0795 in.)
2.04 mm (0.0803 in.)
2.06 mm (0.0811 in.)
2.08 mm (0.0819 in.)
2.10 mm (0.0827 in.)
2.12 mm (0.0835 in.)
Author:
Date:
171
SS–9
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
SS0AE–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
Oil pump pulley x Oil pump drive shaft
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
24
245
18
No.2 idler pulley x Oil pump
42
425
31
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
108
1,100
80
54
37
550
380
40
27
42
425
31
49
Turn 90°
500
Turn 90°
36
Turn 90°
Water bypass pipe x Cylinder head
19
195
14
Spark plug tube x Cylinder head
49
500
36
Camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head
19
190
14
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
44
450
33
RH engine hanger x Generator bracket
25
250
18
Generator bracket x Cylinder head
42
425
31
LH engine hanger x Cylinder head
25
250
18
No.3 timing belt cover x Cylinder head
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
Delivery pipe x Cylinder head
13
130
9
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
19
195
14
34
29
350
300
25
21
EGR valve x intake manifold
13.3
130
10
EGR pipe x Cylinder head
61.2
600
45
Intake manifold stay x Intake manifold
39
398
29
Intake manifold stay x Stiffening plate
39
398
29
Water outlet x Cylinder head
15
150
11
No.2 intake manifold stay x Cylinder head
21
214
15
No.2 intake manifold stay x Intake manifold
42
428
31
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
49
500
36
No.1 exhaust manifold stay x Exhaust manifold
42
425
31
No.1 exhaust manifold stay x Transaxle
42
425
31
No.2 exhaust manifold stay x Exhaust manifold
42
425
31
58
42
591
425
43
31
No.1 rear end plate x Cylinder block
9.3
95
82 in.·lbf
Flywheel (M/T) x Crankshaft
88
900
65
83
850
61
46
64
470
650
34
47
Transaxle (A/T) x Cylinder block
66
670
48
Drive plate x Torque converter clutch
27
280
20
No.2 rear end plate x Cylinder block
9.3
95
82 in.·lbf
Exhaust pipe bracket, No.2 rear end plate x Transaxle
19
195
14
RH stiffener plate x Cylinder block
39
398
29
RH stiffener plate x Transaxle
39
398
29
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft
for use with SST
No.1 idler pulley x Cylinder head
Cylinder head x Cylinder block
1st
2nd
Fuel inlet hose x Delivery pipe
for use with SST
No.2 exhaust manifold stay, LH stiffener plate x Cylinder block
TMC made
TMMK made
Drive plate (A/T) x Crankshaft
Transaxle (M/T) x Cylinder block
14 mm head
17 mm head
Author:
Date:
172
SS–10
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
LH stiffener plate x Transaxle
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
37
42
380
430
27
31
No.2 RH engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
52
530
38
No.2 RH engine mounting bracket x Generator bracket
52
530
38
Rear engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
64
650
47
Front engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
64
650
47
Engine moving control rod x No.2 RH engine mounting bracket
64
650
47
Engine moving control rod x Body
64
650
47
80
44
66
820
450
670
59
32
49
Rear engine mounting insulator x Front frame
66
670
49
LH engine mounting insulator x Frount frame
80
820
59
LH engine mounting insulator x Transaxle
64
650
47
PS pump x PS pump bracket
43
440
32
25.5
260
19
Fuel inlet hose x Fuel filter
29
300
21
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block
59
600
43
25
Turn 90°
250
Turn 90°
18
Turn 90°
Engine balancer x Cylinder block
49
500
36
Rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
13
130
9
Water pump x Cylinder block
8.8
90
78 in.·lbf
Generator drive belt adjusting bar x Cylinder block
22
224
16
PS pump bracket x Cylinder block
43
440
32
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center pipe
56
570
41
Center exhaust pipe x Tailpipe
56
570
41
Support bracket for front exhaust pipe
x Exhaust pipe bracket on No.2 rear end plate
33
330
24
Support stay for front exhaust pipe x Support bracket
33
330
24
Support bracket for front exhaust pipe x Front frame
33
330
24
Support bracket for center exhaust pipe x Body
19
195
14
Support bracket for tailpipe x Body
33
330
24
Front engine mounting insulator x Front frame
M/T
A/T
TMC made
TMMK made for silver color
for green color
A/C compressor x Cylinder block
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
1st
2nd
Author:
Date:
173
SS–11
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
SS076–02
SERVICE DATA
Compression
pressure
at 250 rpm STD 1,500 kPa (15.3 kgf/cm2, 218 psi)
Minimum 1,000 kPa (10.2 kgf/cm2, 145 psi)
Difference of pressure between each cylinder
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 15 psi) or less
Valve
clearance
at cold Intake
Exhaust
Mark 2.500
Mark 2.550
Mark 2.600
Mark 2.650
Mark 2.700
Mark 2.750
Mark 2.800
Mark 2.850
Mark 2.900
Mark 2.950
Mark 3.000
Mark 3.050
Mark 3.100
Mark 3.150
Mark 3.200
Mark 3.250
Mark 3.300
Adjusting shim for repair part
Ignition timing
w/ Terminals TE1 and E1 connected of DLC1
Idle speed
Protrusion from housing side
Cylinder head
Warpage
Valve seat
Refacing angle
Contacting angle
Contacting width
Valve guide bushing bore diameter
8 – 12° BTDC @ idle
700 ± 50 rpm
–
Timing belt
tensioner
0.15 – 0.25 mm (0.006 – 0.010 in.)
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.010 – 0.014 in.)
2.500 mm (0.0984 in.)
2.550 mm (0.1004 in.)
2.600 mm (0.1024 in.)
2.650 mm (0.1043 in.)
2.700 mm (0.1063 in.)
2.750 mm (0.1083 in.)
2.800 mm (0.1102 in.)
2.850 mm (0.1122 in.)
2.900 mm (0.1142 in.)
2.950 mm (0.1161 in.)
3.000 mm (0.1181 in.)
3.050 mm (0.1201 in.)
3.100 mm (0.1220 in.)
3.150 mm (0.1240 in.)
3.200 mm (0.1260 in.)
3.250 mm (0.1280 in.)
3.300 mm (0.1299 in.)
10.0 – 10.8 mm (0.394 – 0.425 in.)
Maximum 0.10 mm (0.039 in.)
STD
O/S 0.05
30°, 45°, 75°
45°
1.0 – 1.4 mm (0.039 – 0.055 in.)
10.295 – 10.313 mm (0.4053 – 0.4080 in.)
10.345 – 10.363 mm (0.4073 – 0.4080 in.)
12 pointed head cylinder head bolt diameter
at tension portion STD 8.95 – 9.05 mm (0.3524 – 0.3563 in.)
Minimum 8.75 mm (0.3445 in.)
Valve guide
bushing
Inside diameter
Outside diameter for repair part
Valve
Valve overall length
Valve face angle
Stem diameter
Stem oil clearance
Margin thickness
STD
O/S 0.05
5.510 – 5.530 mm (0.2169 – 0.2177 in.)
10.333 – 10.344 mm (0.4068 – 0.4072 in.)
10.383 – 10.394 mm (0.4088 – 0.4092 in.)
STD Intake
Exhaust
Minimum Intake
Exhaust
95.45 mm (3.5779 in.)
95.40 mm (3.7559 in.)
94.95 mm (3.7382 in.)
94.90 mm (3.7362 in.)
44.5°
Intake 5.470 – 5.485 mm (0.2154 – 0.2159 in.)
Exhaust 5.465 – 5.480 mm (0.2152 – 0.2157 in.)
STD Intake 0.025 – 0.060 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust 0.030 – 0.065 mm (0.0012 – 0.0026 in.)
Maximum Intake 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
STD 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Maximum 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
Author:
Date:
174
SS–12
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
Valve spring
Deviation
Free length
Installed tension at 33.8 mm (1.331 in.)
Maximum 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
45.50 mm (1.7913 in.)
186 – 206 N (19.0 – 21.0 kgf, 41.9 – 46.3 lbf)
Valve lifter
Lifter diameter
Lifter bore diameter
Oil clearance
30.966 – 30.976 mm (1.2191 – 2.2195 in.)
31.000 – 31.016 mm (1.2205 – 1.2211 in.)
STD 0.024 – 0.050 mm (0.0009 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Camshaft
Thrust clearance
Journal oil clearance
Journal diameter
Circle runout
Cam lobe height
Camshaft gear backlash
Camshaft gear spring end free distance
STD
Maximum
STD Intake
Exhaust
Maximum Intake
Exhaust
0.040 – 0.090 mm (0.0016 – 0.0035 in.)
0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
0.035 – 0.072 mm (0.0014 – 0.0028 in.)
0.025 – 0.062 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
0.09 mm (0.0035 in.)
26.959 – 26.975 mm (1.0613 – 1.0620 in.)
Maximum 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
STD Intake 42.11 – 42.21 mm (1.6579 – 1.6618 in.)
Exhaust 41.96 – 42.06 mm (1.6520 – 1.6559 in.)
Minimum Intake 41.96 mm (1.6520 in.)
Exhaust 41.81 mm (1.6461 in.)
STD 0.020 – 0.200 mm (0.0008 – 0.0079 in.)
Maximum 0.30 mm (0.0188 in.)
18.2 – 18.8 mm (0.712 – 0.740 in.)
Air intake
chamber
Warpage
Maximum 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Intake
manifold
Warpage
Air intake chamber side
Cylinder head side
Maximum 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
Maximum 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust
manifold
Warpage
Maximum 0.50 mm (0.0196 in.)
Cylinder block
Cylinder head surface warpage
Cylinder bore diameter
Maximum 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
87.500 – 87.512 mm (3.4449 – 3.4453 in.)
Maximum 87.52 mm (3.4457 in.)
12 pointed head main bearing cap bolt diameter
at tension portion STD 7.500 – 7.600 mm (0.2953 – 0.2992 in.)
Minimum 7.20 mm (0.2835 in.)
Piston and
piston ring
Piston diameter
AISIN made
at 23.2 mm (0.913 in.) from the piston head
87.406 – 87.416 mm (3.4412 – 3.4416 in.)
at 41.2 mm (1.622 in.) from the piston head
Piston oil clearance
AISIN made
STD
Maximum
MAHLE made
STD
Maximum
Piston ring groove clearance
No.1
No.2
Piston ring end gap
STD No.1
No.2
Oil
Maximum No.1
No.2
Oil
87.453 – 87.467 mm (3.4430 – 3.4436 in.)
MAHLE made
0.084 – 0.106 mm (0.0033 – 0.0042)
0.13 mm (0.0051 in.)
0.033 – 0.059 mm (0.0013 – 0.0023)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
0.020 – 0.070 mm (0.0008 – 0.0028 in.)
0.020 – 0.060 mm (0.0008 – 0.0024 in.)
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.0098 – 0.0138 in.)
0.35 – 0.45 mm (0.0138 – 0.0177 in.)
0.15 – 0.40 mm (0.0059 – 0.0157 in.)
0.95 mm (0.0374 in.)
1.05 mm (0.0413 in.)
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
Author:
Date:
175
SS–13
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Connecting
rod
Thrust clearance
Connecting rod thickness
Connecting rod bearing center wall thickness
Reference
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
STD 0.15 – 0.30 mm (0.0059 – 0.0118 in.)
Maximum 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
20.80 – 20.85 mm (0.8189 – 0.8209 in.)
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 4
Connecting rod oil clearance
STD
Maximum
Rod out–of–alignment
Maximum per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Rod twist
Maximum per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Bushing inside diameter
Piston pin diameter
Bushing oil clearance
STD
Maximum
Connecting rod bolt diameter
at tension portion STD
Minimum
Crankshaft
1.484 – 1.487 mm (0.0584 – 0.0585 in.)
1.487 – 1.490 mm (0.0585 – 0.0587 in.)
1.490 – 1.493 mm (0.0587 – 0.0588 in.)
1.493 – 1.496 mm (0.0588 – 0.0589 in.)
0.038 – 0.064 mm (0.0015 – 0.0025 in.)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
22.005 – 22.014 mm (0.8663 – 0.8667 in.)
21.997 – 22.006 mm (0.8660 – 0.8664 in.)
0.005 – 0.011 mm (0.0002 – 0.0004 in)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
7.2 – 7.3 mm (0.284 – 0.287 in.)
7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
Thrust clearance
STD 0.04 – 0.24 mm (0.0016 – 0.0095 in.)
Maximum 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
Thrust washer thickness
1.930 – 1.980 mm (0.0760 – 0.0780 in.)
Main journal oil clearance
STD No.1 and No.4 0.014 – 0.036 mm (0.0006 – 0.0014 in.)
No.2 and No.3 0.026 – 0.048 mm (0.0010 – 0.0019 in.)
Maximum No.1 and No.4 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
No.2 and No.3 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Main journal diameter
60.988 – 61.000 mm (2.4011 – 2.4016 in.)
Main bearing center wall thickness
Reference (TMC made)
Mark 1 2.486 – 2.489 mm (0.0979 – 0.0980 in.)
Mark 2 2.489 – 2.492 mm (0.0980 – 0.0981 in.)
Mark 3 2.492 – 2.495 mm (0.0981 – 0.0982 in.)
Mark 4 2.495 – 2.498 mm (0.0982 – 0.0983 in.)
M k 5 2.498
Mark
2 498 – 2
2.501
501 mm (0
(0.0983
0983 – 0
0.0985
0985 iin.))
Mark 6 2.501 – 2.504 mm (0.0985 – 0.0986 in.)
Mark 7 2.504 – 2.507 mm (0.0986 – 0.0987 in.)
Reference (TMMK made)
Mark 1 2.485 – 2.488 mm (0.0978 – 0.0980 in.)
Mark 2 2.488 – 2.491 mm (0.0980 – 0.0981 in.)
Mark 3 2.491 – 2.494 mm (0.0981 – 0.0982 in.)
Mark 4 2.494 – 2.497 mm (0.0982 – 0.0983 in.)
Mark 5 2.497 – 2.500 mm (0.0983 – 0.0984 in.)
Mark 6 2.500 – 2.503 mm (0.0984 – 0.0985 in.)
Mark 7 2.503 – 2.506 mm (0.0985 – 0.0987 in.)
Crank pin diameter
52.992 – 53.000 mm (2.0863 – 2.0866 in.)
Circle runout
Maximum 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Main journal taper and out–of–round
Maximum 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Crank pin taper and out–of–round
Maximum 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Author:
Date:
176
SS–14
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
SS077–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Timing belt plate x Oil pump
8
80
69 in.·lbf
No.1 idler pulley x Oil pump
34
350
25
No.2 idler pulley x No.2 idler pulley bracket
43
440
32
125
88
1,300
900
94
65
Timing belt tensioner x Oil pump
27
280
20
RH engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
28
290
21
No.2 timing belt cover x No.3 timing belt cover
8.5
85
74 in.·lbf
No.1 timing belt cover x Oil pump
8.5
85
74 in.·lbf
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
215
2,200
159
No.2 generator bracket x Engine RH mounting bracket
28
290
21
54
Turn 90°
18.5
550
Turn 90°
185
40
Turn 90°
13
Camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head
16
160
12
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
49
500
36
20
34
200
350
15
25
20
34
200
350
15
25
No.1 EGR pipe x RH exhaust manifold
12
120
9
No.1 EGR pipe x EGR cooler
12
120
9
PS pump bracket x RH cylinder head
43
440
32
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft
for SST
Cylinder head x Cylinder block
12 pointed head bolt 1st
2nd
Recessed head bolt
Exhaust manifold stay x Exhaust manifold
Except California A/T and all M/T
California A/T and all M/T
Exhaust manifold stay x Transmission housing
Except California A/T
California A/T
Oil dipstick guide x LH cylinder head
8
80
69 in.·lbf
19.5
200
14
8
80
69 in.·lbf
No.3 timing belt cover x Cylinder head
8.5
85
74 in.·lbf
Water outlet x Intake manifold
15
150
11
Fuel inlet hose x Fuel filter
29
300
21
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
15
150
11
Air intake chamber x Intake manifold
43
440
32
No.2 EGR pipe x Air intake chamber
12
120
9
No.2 EGR pipe x EGR cooler
12
120
9
No.1 engine hanger x Air intake chamber
39
400
29
No.1 engine hanger x RH cylinder head
39
400
29
Air intake chamber stay x Air intake chamber
19.5
200
14
Air intake chamber stay x RH cylinder head
19.5
200
14
Rear engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
64
650
47
Front engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
64
650
47
Engine moving control rod x RH engine mounting bracket
64
650
47
Engine moving control rod x RH fender apron
64
650
47
No.2 RH engine mounting stay x No.2 RH engine mounting bracket
64
650
47
Water inlet pipe x LH cylinder head
Cylinder head rear plate x LH cylinder head
Author:
Date:
177
SS–15
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
No.2 RH engine mounting stay x No.2 Generator bracket
64
650
47
RH engine mounting stay x Water outlet
32
320
23
RH engine mounting stay x Engine moving control rod
32
320
23
RH engine mounting stay x No.2 RH engine mounting bracket
32
320
23
80
44
66
820
450
670
59
32
48
Engine mounting absorber x Front frame
48
490
35
Engine mounting absorber x Transaxle
48
490
35
Rear engine mounting insulator x Front frame
66
670
48
LH engine mounting insulator x Transaxle
64
650
47
PS pump x PS pump bracket
43
440
31
A/C compressor x Housing bracket
25
250
18
A/C compressor x No.1 oil pan
25
250
18
Generator adjusting bar x Drive belt adjusting bar bracket
18
185
13
12 pointed head bolt 1st
2nd
6 pointed head bolt
22
Turn 90°
27
225
Turn 90°
275
16
Turn 90°
20
1st
2nd
24.5
Turn 90°
250
Turn 90°
18
Turn 90°
Rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
8
80
69 in.·lbf
EGR cooler x Cylinder block
9
90
78 in.·lbf
Engine coolant drain union x Cylinder block
39
400
29
Water seal plate x Cylinder block
18
180
13
Oil filter union x Cylinder block
30
310
22
Water inlet housing x Cylinder block
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Knock sensor x Cylinder block
39
400
29
No.2 idler pulley bracket x Cylinder block
28
290
21
A/C compressor housing bracket x Cylinder block
25
250
18
Generator bracket x Cylinder block
43
440
32
Drive plate x Crankshaft
83
850
61
Flywheel x Crankshaft
83
850
61
Front exhaust pipe support bracket x No.1 oil pan
21
210
15
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
Center exhaust pipe x Tailpipe
56
570
41
Front exhaust pipe bracket x Sub frame
33
330
24
Front exhaust pipe support bracket x Front exhaust pipe stay
33
330
24
Heated oxygen sensor x Center exhaust pipe
44
450
33
Front engine mounting insulator x Front frame
TMC made
TMMK made
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block
Silver color bolt
Green color bolt
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
Author:
Date:
178
SS–16
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
SS0AF–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
13.3
136
10
EGR valve x EGR pipe
10
102
7
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
49
500
36
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
EGR valve x Intake manifold
Author:
Date:
179
SS–17
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
SS078–01
SERVICE DATA
EGR valve
position
sensor
Resistance (VC – E2)
Power source voltage (VC– E2)
Power output voltage (EGLS – E2)
at vacuum (17.3 kPa, 130 mmHg, 5.1 in.Hg)
at no vacuum
1.5 – 4.3 kΩ
4.5 – 5.5 V
3.2 – 5.1 V
0.4 – 1.6 V
Author:
Date:
180
SS–18
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
SS079–02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
EGR valve position sensor x EGR valve
2
20
17 in.·lbf
EGR pipe x EGR valve
12
120
9
EGR pipe x EGR cooler
12
120
9
EGR valve x Air intake chamber
12
120
9
EGR gas temperature sensor x EGR valve
20
200
14
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
Front exhaust pipe bracket x Sub frame
33
330
24
Front exhaust pipe support bracket x Front exhaust pipe stay
33
330
24
Author:
Date:
181
SS–19
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SFI (5S–FE)
SFI (5S–FE)
SS0AG–03
SERVICE DATA
Fuel pressure
regulator
Fuel pressure
Fuel pump
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
Injector
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
Injection volume
Difference between each cylinder
Fuel leakage
Throttle body
at no vacuum
Throttle body fully closed angle
Throttle opener setting speed
301 – 347 kPa (3.1 – 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 – 50 psi)
0.2 – 3.0 Ω
13.4 – 14.2 Ω
54 – 69 cm3 (3.3 – 4.2 cu in.) per 15 seconds
7 cm3 (0.4 cu in.) or less
One drop or less per minute
6°
1,300 – 1,500 rpm (w/ Cooling fan OFF)
Throttle
position
sensor
Clearance between stop screw and lever
0 mm (0 in.)
Throttle valve fully open
–
IAC valve
Resistance (+B – ISCC or ISCO)
VSV for EVAP
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
30 – 34 Ω
VSV for vapor
pressure
sensor
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
33 – 39 Ω
VSV for EGR
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
33 – 39 Ω
ECT sensor
Resistance
at –20°C (–4°F)
at 0°C (32°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
at 40°C (104°F)
at 60°C (140°F)
at 80°C (176°F)
10 – 20 kΩ
4 – 7 kΩ
2 – 3 kΩ
0.9 – 1.3 kΩ
0.4 – 0.7 kΩ
0.2 – 0.4 kΩ
IAT sensor
Resistance
at –20°C (–4°F)
at 0°C (32°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
at 40°C (104°F)
at 60°C (140°F)
at 80°C (176°F)
10 – 20 kΩ
4 – 7 kΩ
2 – 3 kΩ
0.9 – 1.3 kΩ
0.4 – 0.7 kΩ
0.2 – 0.4 kΩ
MAP sensor
Power source voltage
4.5 – 5.5 V
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
Power sorce voltage
4.5 – 5.5 V
A/F sensor
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
0.8 – 1.4 Ω
Heated oxygen
sensor
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
11 – 16 Ω
Fuel cut rpm
Fuel return rpm
VTA – E2
VTA – E2
VC – E2
0.2 – 5.7 kΩ
2.0 – 10.2 kΩ
2.5 – 5.9 kΩ
at cold
at hot
17.0 – 24.5 Ω
21.5 – 28.5 Ω
1,500 rpm
Author:
Date:
182
SS–9
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
SS0AE–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
Oil pump pulley x Oil pump drive shaft
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
24
245
18
No.2 idler pulley x Oil pump
42
425
31
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
108
1,100
80
54
37
550
380
40
27
42
425
31
49
Turn 90°
500
Turn 90°
36
Turn 90°
Water bypass pipe x Cylinder head
19
195
14
Spark plug tube x Cylinder head
49
500
36
Camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head
19
190
14
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
44
450
33
RH engine hanger x Generator bracket
25
250
18
Generator bracket x Cylinder head
42
425
31
LH engine hanger x Cylinder head
25
250
18
No.3 timing belt cover x Cylinder head
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
Delivery pipe x Cylinder head
13
130
9
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
19
195
14
34
29
350
300
25
21
EGR valve x intake manifold
13.3
130
10
EGR pipe x Cylinder head
61.2
600
45
Intake manifold stay x Intake manifold
39
398
29
Intake manifold stay x Stiffening plate
39
398
29
Water outlet x Cylinder head
15
150
11
No.2 intake manifold stay x Cylinder head
21
214
15
No.2 intake manifold stay x Intake manifold
42
428
31
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
49
500
36
No.1 exhaust manifold stay x Exhaust manifold
42
425
31
No.1 exhaust manifold stay x Transaxle
42
425
31
No.2 exhaust manifold stay x Exhaust manifold
42
425
31
58
42
591
425
43
31
No.1 rear end plate x Cylinder block
9.3
95
82 in.·lbf
Flywheel (M/T) x Crankshaft
88
900
65
83
850
61
46
64
470
650
34
47
Transaxle (A/T) x Cylinder block
66
670
48
Drive plate x Torque converter clutch
27
280
20
No.2 rear end plate x Cylinder block
9.3
95
82 in.·lbf
Exhaust pipe bracket, No.2 rear end plate x Transaxle
19
195
14
RH stiffener plate x Cylinder block
39
398
29
RH stiffener plate x Transaxle
39
398
29
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft
for use with SST
No.1 idler pulley x Cylinder head
Cylinder head x Cylinder block
1st
2nd
Fuel inlet hose x Delivery pipe
for use with SST
No.2 exhaust manifold stay, LH stiffener plate x Cylinder block
TMC made
TMMK made
Drive plate (A/T) x Crankshaft
Transaxle (M/T) x Cylinder block
14 mm head
17 mm head
Author:
Date:
172
SS–10
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
LH stiffener plate x Transaxle
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (5S–FE)
37
42
380
430
27
31
No.2 RH engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
52
530
38
No.2 RH engine mounting bracket x Generator bracket
52
530
38
Rear engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
64
650
47
Front engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
64
650
47
Engine moving control rod x No.2 RH engine mounting bracket
64
650
47
Engine moving control rod x Body
64
650
47
80
44
66
820
450
670
59
32
49
Rear engine mounting insulator x Front frame
66
670
49
LH engine mounting insulator x Frount frame
80
820
59
LH engine mounting insulator x Transaxle
64
650
47
PS pump x PS pump bracket
43
440
32
25.5
260
19
Fuel inlet hose x Fuel filter
29
300
21
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block
59
600
43
25
Turn 90°
250
Turn 90°
18
Turn 90°
Engine balancer x Cylinder block
49
500
36
Rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
13
130
9
Water pump x Cylinder block
8.8
90
78 in.·lbf
Generator drive belt adjusting bar x Cylinder block
22
224
16
PS pump bracket x Cylinder block
43
440
32
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center pipe
56
570
41
Center exhaust pipe x Tailpipe
56
570
41
Support bracket for front exhaust pipe
x Exhaust pipe bracket on No.2 rear end plate
33
330
24
Support stay for front exhaust pipe x Support bracket
33
330
24
Support bracket for front exhaust pipe x Front frame
33
330
24
Support bracket for center exhaust pipe x Body
19
195
14
Support bracket for tailpipe x Body
33
330
24
Front engine mounting insulator x Front frame
M/T
A/T
TMC made
TMMK made for silver color
for green color
A/C compressor x Cylinder block
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
1st
2nd
Author:
Date:
173
SS–11
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
SS076–02
SERVICE DATA
Compression
pressure
at 250 rpm STD 1,500 kPa (15.3 kgf/cm2, 218 psi)
Minimum 1,000 kPa (10.2 kgf/cm2, 145 psi)
Difference of pressure between each cylinder
100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 15 psi) or less
Valve
clearance
at cold Intake
Exhaust
Mark 2.500
Mark 2.550
Mark 2.600
Mark 2.650
Mark 2.700
Mark 2.750
Mark 2.800
Mark 2.850
Mark 2.900
Mark 2.950
Mark 3.000
Mark 3.050
Mark 3.100
Mark 3.150
Mark 3.200
Mark 3.250
Mark 3.300
Adjusting shim for repair part
Ignition timing
w/ Terminals TE1 and E1 connected of DLC1
Idle speed
Protrusion from housing side
Cylinder head
Warpage
Valve seat
Refacing angle
Contacting angle
Contacting width
Valve guide bushing bore diameter
8 – 12° BTDC @ idle
700 ± 50 rpm
–
Timing belt
tensioner
0.15 – 0.25 mm (0.006 – 0.010 in.)
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.010 – 0.014 in.)
2.500 mm (0.0984 in.)
2.550 mm (0.1004 in.)
2.600 mm (0.1024 in.)
2.650 mm (0.1043 in.)
2.700 mm (0.1063 in.)
2.750 mm (0.1083 in.)
2.800 mm (0.1102 in.)
2.850 mm (0.1122 in.)
2.900 mm (0.1142 in.)
2.950 mm (0.1161 in.)
3.000 mm (0.1181 in.)
3.050 mm (0.1201 in.)
3.100 mm (0.1220 in.)
3.150 mm (0.1240 in.)
3.200 mm (0.1260 in.)
3.250 mm (0.1280 in.)
3.300 mm (0.1299 in.)
10.0 – 10.8 mm (0.394 – 0.425 in.)
Maximum 0.10 mm (0.039 in.)
STD
O/S 0.05
30°, 45°, 75°
45°
1.0 – 1.4 mm (0.039 – 0.055 in.)
10.295 – 10.313 mm (0.4053 – 0.4080 in.)
10.345 – 10.363 mm (0.4073 – 0.4080 in.)
12 pointed head cylinder head bolt diameter
at tension portion STD 8.95 – 9.05 mm (0.3524 – 0.3563 in.)
Minimum 8.75 mm (0.3445 in.)
Valve guide
bushing
Inside diameter
Outside diameter for repair part
Valve
Valve overall length
Valve face angle
Stem diameter
Stem oil clearance
Margin thickness
STD
O/S 0.05
5.510 – 5.530 mm (0.2169 – 0.2177 in.)
10.333 – 10.344 mm (0.4068 – 0.4072 in.)
10.383 – 10.394 mm (0.4088 – 0.4092 in.)
STD Intake
Exhaust
Minimum Intake
Exhaust
95.45 mm (3.5779 in.)
95.40 mm (3.7559 in.)
94.95 mm (3.7382 in.)
94.90 mm (3.7362 in.)
44.5°
Intake 5.470 – 5.485 mm (0.2154 – 0.2159 in.)
Exhaust 5.465 – 5.480 mm (0.2152 – 0.2157 in.)
STD Intake 0.025 – 0.060 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
Exhaust 0.030 – 0.065 mm (0.0012 – 0.0026 in.)
Maximum Intake 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
STD 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Maximum 0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
Author:
Date:
174
SS–12
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
Valve spring
Deviation
Free length
Installed tension at 33.8 mm (1.331 in.)
Maximum 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
45.50 mm (1.7913 in.)
186 – 206 N (19.0 – 21.0 kgf, 41.9 – 46.3 lbf)
Valve lifter
Lifter diameter
Lifter bore diameter
Oil clearance
30.966 – 30.976 mm (1.2191 – 2.2195 in.)
31.000 – 31.016 mm (1.2205 – 1.2211 in.)
STD 0.024 – 0.050 mm (0.0009 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Camshaft
Thrust clearance
Journal oil clearance
Journal diameter
Circle runout
Cam lobe height
Camshaft gear backlash
Camshaft gear spring end free distance
STD
Maximum
STD Intake
Exhaust
Maximum Intake
Exhaust
0.040 – 0.090 mm (0.0016 – 0.0035 in.)
0.12 mm (0.0047 in.)
0.035 – 0.072 mm (0.0014 – 0.0028 in.)
0.025 – 0.062 mm (0.0010 – 0.0024 in.)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
0.09 mm (0.0035 in.)
26.959 – 26.975 mm (1.0613 – 1.0620 in.)
Maximum 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
STD Intake 42.11 – 42.21 mm (1.6579 – 1.6618 in.)
Exhaust 41.96 – 42.06 mm (1.6520 – 1.6559 in.)
Minimum Intake 41.96 mm (1.6520 in.)
Exhaust 41.81 mm (1.6461 in.)
STD 0.020 – 0.200 mm (0.0008 – 0.0079 in.)
Maximum 0.30 mm (0.0188 in.)
18.2 – 18.8 mm (0.712 – 0.740 in.)
Air intake
chamber
Warpage
Maximum 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Intake
manifold
Warpage
Air intake chamber side
Cylinder head side
Maximum 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
Maximum 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust
manifold
Warpage
Maximum 0.50 mm (0.0196 in.)
Cylinder block
Cylinder head surface warpage
Cylinder bore diameter
Maximum 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
87.500 – 87.512 mm (3.4449 – 3.4453 in.)
Maximum 87.52 mm (3.4457 in.)
12 pointed head main bearing cap bolt diameter
at tension portion STD 7.500 – 7.600 mm (0.2953 – 0.2992 in.)
Minimum 7.20 mm (0.2835 in.)
Piston and
piston ring
Piston diameter
AISIN made
at 23.2 mm (0.913 in.) from the piston head
87.406 – 87.416 mm (3.4412 – 3.4416 in.)
at 41.2 mm (1.622 in.) from the piston head
Piston oil clearance
AISIN made
STD
Maximum
MAHLE made
STD
Maximum
Piston ring groove clearance
No.1
No.2
Piston ring end gap
STD No.1
No.2
Oil
Maximum No.1
No.2
Oil
87.453 – 87.467 mm (3.4430 – 3.4436 in.)
MAHLE made
0.084 – 0.106 mm (0.0033 – 0.0042)
0.13 mm (0.0051 in.)
0.033 – 0.059 mm (0.0013 – 0.0023)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
0.020 – 0.070 mm (0.0008 – 0.0028 in.)
0.020 – 0.060 mm (0.0008 – 0.0024 in.)
0.25 – 0.35 mm (0.0098 – 0.0138 in.)
0.35 – 0.45 mm (0.0138 – 0.0177 in.)
0.15 – 0.40 mm (0.0059 – 0.0157 in.)
0.95 mm (0.0374 in.)
1.05 mm (0.0413 in.)
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
Author:
Date:
175
SS–13
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Connecting
rod
Thrust clearance
Connecting rod thickness
Connecting rod bearing center wall thickness
Reference
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
STD 0.15 – 0.30 mm (0.0059 – 0.0118 in.)
Maximum 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
20.80 – 20.85 mm (0.8189 – 0.8209 in.)
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 4
Connecting rod oil clearance
STD
Maximum
Rod out–of–alignment
Maximum per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Rod twist
Maximum per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Bushing inside diameter
Piston pin diameter
Bushing oil clearance
STD
Maximum
Connecting rod bolt diameter
at tension portion STD
Minimum
Crankshaft
1.484 – 1.487 mm (0.0584 – 0.0585 in.)
1.487 – 1.490 mm (0.0585 – 0.0587 in.)
1.490 – 1.493 mm (0.0587 – 0.0588 in.)
1.493 – 1.496 mm (0.0588 – 0.0589 in.)
0.038 – 0.064 mm (0.0015 – 0.0025 in.)
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
22.005 – 22.014 mm (0.8663 – 0.8667 in.)
21.997 – 22.006 mm (0.8660 – 0.8664 in.)
0.005 – 0.011 mm (0.0002 – 0.0004 in)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
7.2 – 7.3 mm (0.284 – 0.287 in.)
7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
Thrust clearance
STD 0.04 – 0.24 mm (0.0016 – 0.0095 in.)
Maximum 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
Thrust washer thickness
1.930 – 1.980 mm (0.0760 – 0.0780 in.)
Main journal oil clearance
STD No.1 and No.4 0.014 – 0.036 mm (0.0006 – 0.0014 in.)
No.2 and No.3 0.026 – 0.048 mm (0.0010 – 0.0019 in.)
Maximum No.1 and No.4 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
No.2 and No.3 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Main journal diameter
60.988 – 61.000 mm (2.4011 – 2.4016 in.)
Main bearing center wall thickness
Reference (TMC made)
Mark 1 2.486 – 2.489 mm (0.0979 – 0.0980 in.)
Mark 2 2.489 – 2.492 mm (0.0980 – 0.0981 in.)
Mark 3 2.492 – 2.495 mm (0.0981 – 0.0982 in.)
Mark 4 2.495 – 2.498 mm (0.0982 – 0.0983 in.)
M k 5 2.498
Mark
2 498 – 2
2.501
501 mm (0
(0.0983
0983 – 0
0.0985
0985 iin.))
Mark 6 2.501 – 2.504 mm (0.0985 – 0.0986 in.)
Mark 7 2.504 – 2.507 mm (0.0986 – 0.0987 in.)
Reference (TMMK made)
Mark 1 2.485 – 2.488 mm (0.0978 – 0.0980 in.)
Mark 2 2.488 – 2.491 mm (0.0980 – 0.0981 in.)
Mark 3 2.491 – 2.494 mm (0.0981 – 0.0982 in.)
Mark 4 2.494 – 2.497 mm (0.0982 – 0.0983 in.)
Mark 5 2.497 – 2.500 mm (0.0983 – 0.0984 in.)
Mark 6 2.500 – 2.503 mm (0.0984 – 0.0985 in.)
Mark 7 2.503 – 2.506 mm (0.0985 – 0.0987 in.)
Crank pin diameter
52.992 – 53.000 mm (2.0863 – 2.0866 in.)
Circle runout
Maximum 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Main journal taper and out–of–round
Maximum 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Crank pin taper and out–of–round
Maximum 0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Author:
Date:
176
SS–14
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
SS077–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Timing belt plate x Oil pump
8
80
69 in.·lbf
No.1 idler pulley x Oil pump
34
350
25
No.2 idler pulley x No.2 idler pulley bracket
43
440
32
125
88
1,300
900
94
65
Timing belt tensioner x Oil pump
27
280
20
RH engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
28
290
21
No.2 timing belt cover x No.3 timing belt cover
8.5
85
74 in.·lbf
No.1 timing belt cover x Oil pump
8.5
85
74 in.·lbf
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
215
2,200
159
No.2 generator bracket x Engine RH mounting bracket
28
290
21
54
Turn 90°
18.5
550
Turn 90°
185
40
Turn 90°
13
Camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head
16
160
12
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
49
500
36
20
34
200
350
15
25
20
34
200
350
15
25
No.1 EGR pipe x RH exhaust manifold
12
120
9
No.1 EGR pipe x EGR cooler
12
120
9
PS pump bracket x RH cylinder head
43
440
32
Camshaft timing pulley x Camshaft
for SST
Cylinder head x Cylinder block
12 pointed head bolt 1st
2nd
Recessed head bolt
Exhaust manifold stay x Exhaust manifold
Except California A/T and all M/T
California A/T and all M/T
Exhaust manifold stay x Transmission housing
Except California A/T
California A/T
Oil dipstick guide x LH cylinder head
8
80
69 in.·lbf
19.5
200
14
8
80
69 in.·lbf
No.3 timing belt cover x Cylinder head
8.5
85
74 in.·lbf
Water outlet x Intake manifold
15
150
11
Fuel inlet hose x Fuel filter
29
300
21
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
15
150
11
Air intake chamber x Intake manifold
43
440
32
No.2 EGR pipe x Air intake chamber
12
120
9
No.2 EGR pipe x EGR cooler
12
120
9
No.1 engine hanger x Air intake chamber
39
400
29
No.1 engine hanger x RH cylinder head
39
400
29
Air intake chamber stay x Air intake chamber
19.5
200
14
Air intake chamber stay x RH cylinder head
19.5
200
14
Rear engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
64
650
47
Front engine mounting insulator x Cylinder block
64
650
47
Engine moving control rod x RH engine mounting bracket
64
650
47
Engine moving control rod x RH fender apron
64
650
47
No.2 RH engine mounting stay x No.2 RH engine mounting bracket
64
650
47
Water inlet pipe x LH cylinder head
Cylinder head rear plate x LH cylinder head
Author:
Date:
177
SS–15
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL (1MZ–FE)
No.2 RH engine mounting stay x No.2 Generator bracket
64
650
47
RH engine mounting stay x Water outlet
32
320
23
RH engine mounting stay x Engine moving control rod
32
320
23
RH engine mounting stay x No.2 RH engine mounting bracket
32
320
23
80
44
66
820
450
670
59
32
48
Engine mounting absorber x Front frame
48
490
35
Engine mounting absorber x Transaxle
48
490
35
Rear engine mounting insulator x Front frame
66
670
48
LH engine mounting insulator x Transaxle
64
650
47
PS pump x PS pump bracket
43
440
31
A/C compressor x Housing bracket
25
250
18
A/C compressor x No.1 oil pan
25
250
18
Generator adjusting bar x Drive belt adjusting bar bracket
18
185
13
12 pointed head bolt 1st
2nd
6 pointed head bolt
22
Turn 90°
27
225
Turn 90°
275
16
Turn 90°
20
1st
2nd
24.5
Turn 90°
250
Turn 90°
18
Turn 90°
Rear oil seal retainer x Cylinder block
8
80
69 in.·lbf
EGR cooler x Cylinder block
9
90
78 in.·lbf
Engine coolant drain union x Cylinder block
39
400
29
Water seal plate x Cylinder block
18
180
13
Oil filter union x Cylinder block
30
310
22
Water inlet housing x Cylinder block
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Knock sensor x Cylinder block
39
400
29
No.2 idler pulley bracket x Cylinder block
28
290
21
A/C compressor housing bracket x Cylinder block
25
250
18
Generator bracket x Cylinder block
43
440
32
Drive plate x Crankshaft
83
850
61
Flywheel x Crankshaft
83
850
61
Front exhaust pipe support bracket x No.1 oil pan
21
210
15
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
Center exhaust pipe x Tailpipe
56
570
41
Front exhaust pipe bracket x Sub frame
33
330
24
Front exhaust pipe support bracket x Front exhaust pipe stay
33
330
24
Heated oxygen sensor x Center exhaust pipe
44
450
33
Front engine mounting insulator x Front frame
TMC made
TMMK made
Main bearing cap x Cylinder block
Silver color bolt
Green color bolt
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
Author:
Date:
178
SS–16
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
SS0AF–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
13.3
136
10
EGR valve x EGR pipe
10
102
7
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
49
500
36
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
EGR valve x Intake manifold
Author:
Date:
179
SS–17
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
SS078–01
SERVICE DATA
EGR valve
position
sensor
Resistance (VC – E2)
Power source voltage (VC– E2)
Power output voltage (EGLS – E2)
at vacuum (17.3 kPa, 130 mmHg, 5.1 in.Hg)
at no vacuum
1.5 – 4.3 kΩ
4.5 – 5.5 V
3.2 – 5.1 V
0.4 – 1.6 V
Author:
Date:
180
SS–18
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
SS079–02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
EGR valve position sensor x EGR valve
2
20
17 in.·lbf
EGR pipe x EGR valve
12
120
9
EGR pipe x EGR cooler
12
120
9
EGR valve x Air intake chamber
12
120
9
EGR gas temperature sensor x EGR valve
20
200
14
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
Front exhaust pipe bracket x Sub frame
33
330
24
Front exhaust pipe support bracket x Front exhaust pipe stay
33
330
24
Author:
Date:
181
SS–19
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SFI (5S–FE)
SFI (5S–FE)
SS0AG–03
SERVICE DATA
Fuel pressure
regulator
Fuel pressure
Fuel pump
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
Injector
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
Injection volume
Difference between each cylinder
Fuel leakage
Throttle body
at no vacuum
Throttle body fully closed angle
Throttle opener setting speed
301 – 347 kPa (3.1 – 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 – 50 psi)
0.2 – 3.0 Ω
13.4 – 14.2 Ω
54 – 69 cm3 (3.3 – 4.2 cu in.) per 15 seconds
7 cm3 (0.4 cu in.) or less
One drop or less per minute
6°
1,300 – 1,500 rpm (w/ Cooling fan OFF)
Throttle
position
sensor
Clearance between stop screw and lever
0 mm (0 in.)
Throttle valve fully open
–
IAC valve
Resistance (+B – ISCC or ISCO)
VSV for EVAP
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
30 – 34 Ω
VSV for vapor
pressure
sensor
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
33 – 39 Ω
VSV for EGR
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
33 – 39 Ω
ECT sensor
Resistance
at –20°C (–4°F)
at 0°C (32°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
at 40°C (104°F)
at 60°C (140°F)
at 80°C (176°F)
10 – 20 kΩ
4 – 7 kΩ
2 – 3 kΩ
0.9 – 1.3 kΩ
0.4 – 0.7 kΩ
0.2 – 0.4 kΩ
IAT sensor
Resistance
at –20°C (–4°F)
at 0°C (32°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
at 40°C (104°F)
at 60°C (140°F)
at 80°C (176°F)
10 – 20 kΩ
4 – 7 kΩ
2 – 3 kΩ
0.9 – 1.3 kΩ
0.4 – 0.7 kΩ
0.2 – 0.4 kΩ
MAP sensor
Power source voltage
4.5 – 5.5 V
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
Power sorce voltage
4.5 – 5.5 V
A/F sensor
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
0.8 – 1.4 Ω
Heated oxygen
sensor
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
11 – 16 Ω
Fuel cut rpm
Fuel return rpm
VTA – E2
VTA – E2
VC – E2
0.2 – 5.7 kΩ
2.0 – 10.2 kΩ
2.5 – 5.9 kΩ
at cold
at hot
17.0 – 24.5 Ω
21.5 – 28.5 Ω
1,500 rpm
Author:
Date:
182
SS–20
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SFI (5S–FE)
SS0AH–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
29
28
300
285
21
21
Fuel pump assembly x Fuel tank
4
40
35 in.·lbf
Fuel filter x Fuel pump bracket
2
20
17 in.·lbf
Fuel pressure regulator x Fuel pump bracket
2
20
17 in.·lbf
Delivery pipe x Cylinder head
13
130
9
Fuel tank band x Body
39
400
29
Throttle body x Intake manifold
19
195
14
Knock sensor 1 x Cylinder block
44
450
32
A/F sensor x Exhaust manifold
44
450
32
Oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 1) x Exhaust manifold
44
450
32
Oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2) x Front exhaust pipe
44
450
32
Fuel line
Union bolt type
Flare nut type
for use with SST
Author:
Date:
183
SS–21
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SFI (1MZ–FE)
SFI (1MZ–FE)
SS109–02
SERVICE DATA
Fuel pressure
Fuel pump
Resistance
Injector
Resistance
Injection volume
Difference between each cylinder
Fuel leakage
MAF meter
Resistance (THA – E2)
Throttle body
Throttle opener setting speed
Throttle
position
sensor
Resistance
Throttle valve fully closed
Throttle valve fully open
–
IAC valve
Resistance (+B – RSO or RSC)
VSV for EGR
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
27 – 33 Ω
VSV for EVAP
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
27 – 33 Ω
VSV for ACIS
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
33 – 39 Ω
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
33 – 39 Ω
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
at no vacuum
301 – 347 kPa (3.1 – 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 – 50 psi)
Fuel pressure
regulator
at 20°C (68°F)
0.2 – 3.0 Ω
13.4 − 14.2 Ω
60 – 73 cm3 (3.4 – 4.5 cu in.) per 15 sec.
13 cm3 (0.8 cu in.) or less
1 drop or less per 12 minute
at –20°C (–4°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
at 60°C (140°F)
14.6 – 17.8 kΩ
2.21 – 2.69 kΩ
0.29 – 0.35 kΩ
900 – 1,950 rpm
VTA – E2
VTA – E2
VC – E2
0.2 – 6.3 kΩ
2.0 – 10.2 kΩ
2.5 – 5.9 kΩ
at cold
at hot
17.0 – 25.0 Ω
21.5 – 29.5 Ω
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
Power source voltage
4.5 – 5.5 V
ECT sensor
Resistance
at –20°C (–4°F)
at 0°C (32°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
at 40°C (104°F)
at 60°C (140°F)
at 80°C (176°F)
10 – 20 kΩ
4 – 7 kΩ
2 – 3 kΩ
0.9 – 1.3 kΩ
0.4 – 0.7 kΩ
0.2 – 0.4 kΩ
EGR gas
temperature
sensor
Resistance
at 50°C (122°F)
at 100°C (212°F)
at 150°C (302°F)
64 – 97 kΩ
11 – 16 kΩ
2 – 4 kΩ
A/F sensor
Heater coil resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
at 800°C (1472°F)
0.8 – 1.4 Ω
1.8 – 3.2 Ω
Heated
oxygen sensor
Heater coil resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
at 800°C (1472°F)
11 – 16 Ω
23 – 32 Ω
Fuel cut rpm
Fuel return rpm
1,200 rpm
Author:
Date:
184
SS–22
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SFI (1MZ–FE)
SS10A–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
Fuel line (Union bolt type)
Fuel line (Flare nut type)
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
29
300
21
28
285
21
Fuel pump assembly x Fuel tank
4
40
35 in.·lbf
Fuel filter x Fuel pump bracket
2
20
17 in.·lbf
Fuel pressure regulator x Fuel pump bracket
2
20
17 in.·lbf
Delivery pipe x Intake manifold
10
100
7
No.1 fuel pipe x Intake manifold
19.5
200
14
39
400
29
Throttle body x Air intake chamber
19.5
200
14
Intake air control valve x Air intake chamber
14.5
145
10
ECT sensor x Water outlet
20
200
14
Knock sensor x Cylinder block
39
400
29
A/F sensor x Exhaust manifold
44
450
32
Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1, 2 sensor 1) x Exhaust manifold
44
450
32
Heated oxygen sensor (Bank 1 sensor 2) x Exhaust pipe
44
450
32
Fuel tank band x Body
using SST
N·m
Author:
Date:
185
SS–23
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
COOLING (5S–FE)
COOLING (5S–FE)
SS0AI–03
SERVICE DATA
Thermostat
Valve opening temperature
Valve lift
Radiator cap
Relief valve opening pressure
Electric
cooling fan
Rotating amperage
at 95°C (203°F)
80 – 84°C (176 – 183°F)
8 mm (0.31 in.) or more
STD 74 – 103 kPa (0.75 – 1.05 kgf/cm2, 10.7 – 14.9 psi)
Minimum 59 kPa (0.6 kgf/cm2, 8.5 psi)
4.9 – 8.5 A
Author:
Date:
186
SS–24
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
COOLING (5S–FE)
SS0AJ–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Cylinder block x Drain plug
25
250
18
Water pump x Water pump cover, Cylinder block
8.8
90
78 in.·lbf
Water bypass pipe x Water pump cover
9.3
95
82 in.·lbf
Generator drive belt adjusting bar x Cylinder block
22
224
16
Water inlet x Water pump cover
8.8
90
78 in.·lbf
Oil cooler x Radiator lower tank
8.3
85
74 in.·lbf
Oil cooler pipe x Oil cooler
14.7
150
11
Upper radiator support x Body
12.8
130
9
Electric cooling fan x Radiator
5.0
50
44 in.·lbf
Author:
Date:
187
SS–25
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
SS07C–01
SERVICE DATA
Thermostat
Valve opening pressure
Valve lift
Radiator cap
Relief valve opening pressure
Radiator
Plate height
Cooling fan
Rotating amperage
at 95°C (203°F)
80 – 84°C (176 – 183°F)
10.0 mm (0.394 in.) or more
STD 83 – 113 kPa (0.85 – 1.15 kgf/cm2, 12.1 – 16.4 psi)
Minimum 69 kPa (0.7 kgf/cm2, 10.0 psi)
7.4 – 7.8 mm (0.2959 – 0.3119 in.)
at 20°C (68°F) No.1
No.2
8.3 – 11.3 A
8.3 – 11.3 A
Author:
Date:
188
SS–26
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
SS07D–02
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
RH engine drain plug x EGR cooler
7
70
61 in.·lbf
LH engine drain plug x Union on cylinder block
13
130
9
Water pump x Cylinder block
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Water inlet x Water inlet housing
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Water inlet pipe x LH cylinder head
19.5
200
14
Radiator support x Body
12.8
130
9
No.1 cooling fan shroud x Radiator
5.0
50
44 in.·lbf
No.2 cooling fan shroud x Radiator
5.0
50
44 in.·lbf
Radiator oil cooler x Radiator lower tank
8.3
85
74 in.·lbf
Radiator inlet pipe x Radiator lower tank
14.7
150
11
Author:
Date:
189
SS–27
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
SS0AK–03
SERVICE DATA
Oil pressure
Oil pump
at idle speed
at 3,000 rpm
Body clearance
Tip clearance
STD
Maximum
STD
Maximum
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi) or more
245 – 490 kPa (2.5 – 5.0 kgf/cm2, 36 – 71 psi)
0.10 – 0.16 mm (0.0039 – 0.0063 in.)
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.04 – 0.16 mm (0.0016 – 0.0063 in.)
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
Author:
Date:
190
SS–28
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
LUBRICATION (5S–FE)
SS0AL–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Oil pan x Drain plug
37
375
27
Oil pump body cover x Oil pump body
8.8
90
78 in.·lbf
Oil pump x Cylinder block
8.8
90
78 in.·lbf
Oil strainer x Engine balancer
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Oil strainer x Oil pump
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Oil pan x Cylinder block
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Oil pan x Oil pump
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
78.5
9.0
800
92
58
80 in.·lbf
Oil cooler x Cylinder block
Union bolt
Nut
Author:
Date:
191
SS–29
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
SS07E–01
SERVICE DATA
Oil pressure
Oil pump
at idle speed
at 3,000 rpm
Side clearance
Body clearance
Tip clearance
STD
Maximum
STD
Maximum
STD
Maximum
29 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 43 psi) or more
294 – 539 kPa (3.0 – 5.5 kgf/cm2, 43 – 78 psi)
0.030 – 0.090 mm (0.0012 – 0.0035 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
0.100 – 0.175 mm (0.0039 – 0.0069 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
0.110 – 0.240 mm (0.0043 – 0.0094 in.)
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
Author:
Date:
192
SS–30
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
LUBRICATION (1MZ–FE)
SS07F–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
Oil pressure switch x Cylinder block
No.2 oil pan x Drain plug
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
13
130
9
45
460
33
36.8
375
37
8
19.5
80
200
69 in.·lbf
14
Crankshaft position sensor x Oil pump
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Oil pan baffle plate x No.1 oil pan
8
80
69 in.·lbf
19.5
200
14
8
19.5
80
200
69 in.·lbf
14
8
80
69 in.·lbf
37.2
380
27
Oil strainer x Main bearing cap
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Oil strainer x Oil pump
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Oil pump x Relief valve plug
Oil pump x Cylinder block
10 mm head
12 mm head
No.1 oil pan x Cylinder block
No.1 oil pan x Oil pump
No.1 oil pan x Rear oil seal retainer
No.1 oil pan x Transaxle
No.2 oil pan x No.1 oil pan
10 mm head
12 mm head
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Flywheel housing under cover x Transaxle
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
A/C compressor x A/C compressor housing bracket
25
250
18
PS pump x PS pump bracket
43
440
32
PS pump drive belt adjusting strut x PS pump
43
440
32
PS pump drive belt adjusting strut x Oil pump
43
440
32
Exhaust pipe bracket x No.1 oil pan
21
210
15
Author:
Date:
193
SS–31
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
IGNITION (5S–FE)
IGNITION (5S–FE)
SS0AM–03
SERVICE DATA
Firing order
–
High–tension
cord
Resistance
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
1–3–4–2
Maximum 25 kΩ per cord
DENSO made
NGK made
Correct electrode gap for new spark plug
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug
PK20TR11
BKR6EKPB11
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
Ignition coil
Secondary coil resistance
at cold
at hot
9.7 – 16.7 kΩ
12.4 – 19.6 kΩ
Camshaft
position
sensor
Resistance
at cold
at hot
835 – 1,400 Ω
1,060 – 1,645 Ω
Crankshaft
position
sensor
Resistance
at cold
at hot
985 – 1,600 Ω
1,265 – 1,890 Ω
Author:
Date:
194
SS–32
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
IGNITION (5S–FE)
SS0AN–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head
18
180
13
Ignition coil x No.2 intake manifold stay
9.8
100
87 in.·lbf
No.2 intake manifold stay x Cylinder head
21
214
15
No.2 intake manifold stay x Intake manifold
42
428
31
Camshaft position sensor assembly x Cylinder head
9.5
97
84 in.·lbf
Crankshaft position sensor x Oil pump
9.5
97
84 in.·lbf
Author:
Date:
195
SS–33
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
SS07G–02
SERVICE DATA
Firing order
–
High–tension
cord
Resistance
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
1–2–3–4–5–6
Maximum 25 kΩ per cord
DENSO made
NGK made
Correct electrode gap for new plug
Maximum electrode gap for used plug
Ignition coil
Primary coil resistance
Secondary coil resistance
AISAN made
Diamond made
Camshaft
position
sensor
Resistance
DENSO made
Wabash made
Crankshaft
position
sensor
Resistance
PK20TR11
BKR6EKPB11
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
at cold
at hot
0.70 – 0.94 Ω
0.85 – 1.10 Ω
at cold
at hot
at cold
at hot
10.8 – 14.9 kΩ
13.1 – 17.5 kΩ
6.8 – 11.7 kΩ
8.6 – 13.7 kΩ
at cold
at hot
at cold
at hot
835 – 1,400 Ω
1,060 – 1,645 Ω
1,690 – 2,560 Ω
2,145 – 3,010 Ω
at cold
at hot
1,630 – 2,740 Ω
2,065 – 3,225 Ω
Author:
Date:
196
SS–34
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
IGNITION (1MZ–FE)
SS07H–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head
18
180
13
Ignition coil x Cylinder head
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Camshaft position sensor x Cylinder head
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Crankshaft position sensor x Oil pump
8
80
69 in.·lbf
Author:
Date:
197
SS–35
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STARTING (5S–FE)
STARTING(5S–FE)
SS0AO–01
SERVICE DATA
Starter
Rated voltage and output power
No–load characteristics
Brush length
Spring installed load
Commutator
Diameter
Undercut depth
Circle runout
Magnetic switch
Contact plate for wear
Current
rpm
STD
Minimum
STD 1.2 kW
1.4 kW
Minimum 1.2 kW
1.4 kW
STD
Minimum
STD
Minimum
Maximum
12 V 1.2 kW, 1.4 kW
90 A or less at 11.5 V
3,000 rpm or more
15.5 mm (0.610 in.)
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
13.7 – 19.6 N (1.4 – 2.0 kgf, 3.0 – 4.4 lbf)
17.6 – 23.5 N (1.8 – 2.4 kgf, 3.9 – 5.3 lbf)
9.8 N (1.0 kgf, 2.2 lbf)
11.8 N (1.2 kgf, 2.6 lbf)
30.0 mm (1.181 in.)
29.0 mm (1.142 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Maximum 0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
Author:
Date:
198
SS–36
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STARTING (5S–FE)
SS0AP–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Starter mounting bolt
37
380
27
End cover x Field frame
1.5
15
13 in.·lbf
Starter housing x Magnetic switch
5.9
60
52 in.·lbf
Field frame x Armature assembly
5.9
60
52 in.·lbf
Lead wire x Terminal C of starter
5.9
60
52 in.·lbf
Terminal nut x Terminal C of starter
17
173
13
Terminal nut x Terminal 30 of starter
17
173
13
Magnetic switch end cover x Magnetic switch housing
2.5
26
23 in.·lbf
Author:
Date:
199
SS–37
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
SS07I–01
SERVICE DATA
Starter
Rated voltage and output power
No–load characteristics
Brush length
Spring installed load
Commutator
Diameter
Undercut depth
Circle runout
Magnetic switch
Contact plate for wear
Current
rpm
STD
Minimum
STD
Minimum
12 V 1.4 kW
90 A or less at 11.5 V
3,000 rpm or more
15.5 mm (0.610 in.)
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
17.6 – 23.5 N (1.8 – 2.4 kgf, 3.9 – 5.3 lbf)
11.8 N (1.2 kgf, 2.6 lbf)
STD
Minimum
STD
Minimum
Maximum
30.0 mm (1.181 in.)
29.0 mm (1.142 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
0.2 mm (0.008 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Maximum 0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
Author:
Date:
200
SS–38
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STARTING (1MZ–FE)
SS07J–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Starter mounting bolt
37
380
27
End cover x Field frame
1.5
15
13 in.·lbf
Starter housing x Magnetic switch
5.9
60
52 in.·lbf
Field frame x Armature assembly
5.9
60
52 in.·lbf
Lead wire x Terminal C of starter
5.9
60
52 in.·lbf
Terminal nut x Terminal C of starter
17
170
12
Terminal nut x Terminal 30 of starter
17
170
12
Magnetic switch end cover x Magnetic switch housing
2.5
26
23 in.·lbf
Author:
Date:
201
SS–39
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
CHARGING (5S–FE)
CHARGING(5S–FE)
SS0AQ–01
SERVICE DATA
Battery
Specific gravity (Except maintenance–free battery)
at 20°C (68°F)
Voltage (Maintenance–free battery)
at 20°C (68°F)
Drive belt
Tension
Generator
Rated output
Rotor coil resistance
Slip ring diameter
Brush exposed length
Voltage
regulator
Regulating voltage
w/ A/C New belt
Used belt
w/o A/C New belt
Used belt
at 20°C (68°F)
STD
Minimum
STD
Minimum
1.25 – 1.29
12.5 – 12.9 V
165 ± 25 lbf
110 ± 10 lbf
125 ± 25 lbf
95 ± 20 lbf
12 V 80 A
2.7 – 3.1 Ω
14.2 – 14.4 mm (0.559 – 0.567 in.)
12.8 mm (0.504 in.)
10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
13.5 – 15.1 V
Author:
Date:
202
SS–40
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
CHARGING (5S–FE)
SS0AR–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Bearing retainer x Drive end frame
3.0
31
27 in.·lbf
Rectifier end frame x Drive end frame
4.5
46
40 in.·lbf
Wire clip x Rectifier end frame
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
110.5
1,125
81
Rectifier holder x Coil lead on rectifier end frame
2.9
30
26 in.·lbf
Voltage regulator x Rectifier end flame
2.0
20
18 in.·lbf
Voltage regulator x Rectifier holder
2.0
20
18 in.·lbf
Brush holder x Rectifier holder
2.0
20
18 in.·lbf
Brush holder x Voltage regulator
2.0
20
18 in.·lbf
Rear end cover x Rectifier holder
4.4
45
39 in.·lbf
4.4
3.9
45
39
39 in.·lbf
35 in.·lbf
Generator pulley x Rotor
Plate terminal x Rectifier holder
Nut
Bolt
Terminal insulator x Rectifier holder
4.1
42
36 in.·lbf
Generator x Generator bracket
52
530
38
Generator x Adjusting bar
18
185
13
Author:
Date:
203
SS–41
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
SS07K–01
SERVICE DATA
Battery
Voltage
Drive belt
Tension
New belt
Used belt
Generator
Rated output
Rotor coil resistance
Slip ring diameter
Brush exposed length
Voltage
regulator
Regulating voltage
at 20°C (68°F)
12.5 – 12.9 V
175 ± 5 lbf
115 ± 20 lbf
at 20°C (68°F)
STD
Limit
STD
Limit
12 V 80 A
2.1 – 2.5 Ω
14.2 – 14.4 mm (0.559 – 0.567 in.)
12.8 mm (0.504 in.)
10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
13.5 – 15.1 V
Author:
Date:
204
SS–42
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
SS07L–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Bearing retainer x Drive end frame
3.0
31
27 in.·lbf
Rectifier end frame x Drive end frame
4.5
46
40 in.·lbf
Cord clip x Rectifier end frame
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
110.5
1,125
81
Rectifier holder x Coil lead on rectifier end frame
2.9
30
26 in.·lbf
Voltage regulator and brush holder x Rectifier end frame
2.0
20
18 in.·lbf
4.4
3.9
45
39
39 in.·lbf
35 in.·lbf
Rear end cover x Rectifier holder
4.4
45
39 in.·lbf
Terminal insulator x Rectifier holder
4.1
42
36 in.·lbf
Generator x Generator bracket
56
570
41
Generator x Adjusting bar
18
180
13
Generator pulley x Rotor
Plate terminal x Rectifier holder
Nut
Screw
Author:
Date:
205
SS–43
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
CLUTCH
CLUTCH
SS09Q–01
SERVICE DATA
Pedal height from asphalt sheet
1MZ–FE 161.8 – 171.8 mm (6.370 – 6.764 in.)
Pedal height from asphalt sheet
5S–FE 156.8 – 166.8 mm (6.173 – 6.567 in.)
Push rod play at pedal top
1.0 – 5.0 mm (0.039 – 0.197 in.)
Pedal freeplay
5.0 – 15.0 mm (0.197 – 0.591 in.)
Clutch start switch ON–OFF Stroke
5.0 ± 0.5 mm (0.197 ± 0.020 in.)
Clutch release point from pedal full stroke end position
25 mm (0.98 in.) or more
Disc rivet head depth
Min. 0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
Disc runout
Max.
0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
Flywheel runout
Max.
0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
Diaphragm spring finger wear
Max. depth
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
Diaphragm spring finger wear
Max. width
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
Max.
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
Diaphragm spring tip non–alignment
Author:
Date:
206
SS–44
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
CLUTCH
SS09R–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Master cylinder installation nut
12
120
9
Clutch line
15
155
11
Release cylinder installation bolt
12
120
9
Bleeder plug
8.4
85
74 in.·lbf
Cruise control actuator bracket x Body
13
130
9
Starter x Transaxle
39
400
29
Clutch accumulator installation bolt
21
210
15
Clutch accumulator installation nut
27
270
20
Release fork support
1MZ–FE
47
480
35
Release fork support
5S–FE
39
400
29
19
195
14
Clutch cover x Flywheel
Author:
Date:
207
SS–45
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
SS09O–01
SERVICE DATA
Input shaft
3rd & 4th gears journal diameter
5th gear journal diameter
Runout
Min. 35.950 mm (1.4154 in.)
Min. 27.950 mm (1.1004 in.)
Max. 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Output shaft
1st & 2nd gears journal diameter
Runout
Min. 38.950 mm (1.5335 in.)
Max. 0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Oil pump clearance
Rotor body
STD
Max.
STD
Max.
STD
Max.
0.10 – 0.16 mm (0.0039 – 0.0063 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
0.08 – 0.15 mm (0.0031 – 0.0059 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
0.03 – 0.08 mm (0.0012 – 0.0031 in.)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
STD
Max.
STD
Max.
STD
Max.
STD
Max.
0.10 – 0.35 mm (0.0039 – 0.0138 in.)
0.40 mm (0.0157 in.)
0.10 – 0.45 mm (0.0039 – 0.0177 in.)
0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
0.10 – 0.55 mm (0.0039 – 0.0217 in.)
0.60 mm (0.0236 in.)
0.10 – 0.57 mm (0.0039 – 0.0224 in.)
0.65 mm (0.0256 in.)
Gear radial clearance
1st & 4th
2nd & 3rd
5th
1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th & 5th
STD
STD
STD
Max.
0.009 – 0.051 mm (0.0004 – 0.0020 in.)
0.009 – 0.053 mm (0.0004 – 0.0021 in.)
0.009 – 0.050 mm (0.0004 – 0.0020 in.)
0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
Shift fork to hub sleeve clearance
Max.
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Synchronizer ring to gear clearance
1st, 4th & 5th
2nd & 3rd
Min. 0.8 mm (0.031 in.)
Min. 0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
Rotor tip
Rotor side
Gear thrust clearance
1st & 3rd
2nd
4th
5th
Drive in depth
Control shaft cover oil seal
Select inner lever slotted spring pin
No.1 shift inner lever slotted spring pin
No.2 shift inner lever slotted spring pin
Input shaft snap ring thickness
No.2 clutch hub
0 – 1.0 mm (0 – 0.039 in.)
0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.020 in.)
0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.020 in.)
0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.020 in.)
Mark
H
J
K
L
M
N
P
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
2.35 mm (0.0925 in.)
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
2.45 mm (0.0965 in.)
2.50 mm (0.0984 in.)
2.55 mm (0.1004 in.)
2.60 mm (0.1024 in.)
Author:
Date:
208
SS–46
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Input shaft snap ring thickness
No.3 clutch hub
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
Mark
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
h
j
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1.75 mm (0.0689 in.)
1.80 mm (0.0709 in.)
1.85 mm (0.0729 in.)
1.90 mm (0.0748 in.)
1.95 mm (0.0768 in.)
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
2.05 mm (0.0807 in.)
2.10 mm (0.0827 in.)
2.15 mm (0.0847 in.)
2.35 mm (0.0925 in.)
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
2.45 mm (0.0965 in.)
2.50 mm (0.0984 in.)
2.55 mm (0.1004 in.)
2.60 mm (0.1024 in.)
2.65 mm (0.1043 in.)
2.70 mm (0.1063 in.)
Output shaft snap ring thickness
No.1 clutch hub
Mark
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
2.80 mm (0.1102 in.)
2.85 mm (0.1122 in.)
2.90 mm (0.1142 in.)
2.95 mm (0.1161 in.)
3.00 mm (0.1181 in.)
3.05 mm (0.1201 in.)
3.10 mm (0.1220 in.)
Differential pinion to side gear backlash
STD
0.05–0.20 mm (0.0020–0.0079 in.)
Ball bearing
Differential side gear thrust washer thickness
0.80 mm (0.0315 in.)
0.90 mm (0.0354 in.)
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
1.10 mm (0.0433 in.)
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
1.30 mm (0.0512 in.)
1.40 mm (0.0551 in.)
Differential case side bearing preload (at starting)
New bearing (Output shaft preload plus)
Reused bearing (Output shaft preload plus)
Differential side bearing adjusting shim thickness
0.2 – 0.3 N·m (1.8 – 3.5 kgf·cm, 1.6 – 3.0 in.·lbf)
0.1 – 0.2 N·m (1.1 – 2.2 kgf·cm, 1.0 – 1.9 in.·lbf)
Mark
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
2.05 mm (0.0807 in.)
2.10 mm (0.0827 in.)
2.15 mm (0.0846 in.)
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
2.25 mm (0.0886 in.)
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
2.35 mm (0.0925 in.)
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
2.45 mm (0.0965 in.)
2.50 mm (0.0984 in.)
2.55 mm (0.1004 in.)
2.60 mm (0.1024 in.)
2.65 mm (0.1043 in.)
2.70 mm (0.1063 in.)
2.75 mm (0.1083 in.)
2.80 mm (0.1102 in.)
2.85 mm (0.1122 in.)
Author:
Date:
209
SS–47
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
Output shaft bearing preload (at starting)
New bearing
Reused bearing
Output shaft rear bearing adjusting shim thickness
0.8 – 1.6 N·m (8 – 16 kgf·cm, 6.9 – 13.9 in.·lbf)
0.5 – 1.0 N·m (5 – 10 kgf·cm, 4.3 – 8.7 in.·lbf)
Mark
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
P
Q
1.30 mm (0.0512 in.)
1.35 mm (0.0531 in.)
1.40 mm (0.0551 in.)
1.45 mm (0.0571 in.)
1.50 mm (0.0591 in.)
1.55 mm (0.0610 in.)
1.60 mm (0.0630 in.)
1.65 mm (0.0650 in.)
1.70 mm (0.0669 in.)
1.75 mm (0.0689 in.)
1.80 mm (0.0709 in.)
1.85 mm (0.0728 in.)
1.90 mm (0.0748 in.)
1.95 mm (0.0768 in.)
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
2.05 mm (0.0807 in.)
2.10 mm (0.0827 in.)
2.15 mm (0.0846 in.)
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
2.25 mm (0.0886 in.)
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
2.35 mm (0.0925 in.)
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
2.45 mm (0.0965 in.)
2.50 mm (0.0984 in.)
Author:
Date:
210
SS–48
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
SS09P–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
64
46
37
650
470
380
47
34
27
Cruise control actuator x Body (w/ Cruise control)
13
130
9
Starter x Transaxle
39
400
29
Clutch release cylinder x Transaxle
12
120
9
21
26
210
270
15
20
Clutch line bracket x Transaxle
12
120
9
Front wheel
103
1,050
76
Exhaust pipe support stay
33
330
24
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
No.1 exhaust pipe support bracket x Front suspension member
33
330
24
Stabilizer bar link x Stabilizer bar
39
400
29
Stabilizer bar bracket x Front suspension member
19
195
14
PS gear assembly x Front suspension member
181
1,850
134
Front engine absorber x Transaxle
48
490
35
RH exhaust manifold stay
20
200
14
44
66
450
670
33
48
LH engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
80
820
59
LH engine mounting bracket x Transaxle
64
650
47
Rear engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
66
670
48
Transaxle x Engine
(See page MX–4)
17 mm head
14 mm head A
14 mm head B
Clutch acummulator x Transaxle
Front engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
Bolt
Nut
Silver bolt
Green bolt
Steering return pipe x Front suspension member
10
100
7
181
32
36
1,850
330
370
134
24
27
Flywheel housing under cover x Transaxle
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
Shift cable grommet retainer x Body
4.9
50
43 in.·lbf
Shift lever assembly x Body
12
120
9
No.2 selecting bellcrank with selecting bellcrank support
20
200
14
Shift and select lever shaft lock bolt
49
500
36
Shift and select lever shaft assembly x Transmission case
20
200
14
Transmission case cover x Transmission case
29
300
22
Front suspension member with lower suspension arm
(See page MX–4)
Bolt A
Bolt B
Nut C
Breather plug
49
500
36
Output shaft lock nut
123
1,250
90
Shift fork and shift head set bolt
24
240
17
Rear bearing retainer x Transmission case
42
430
31
Straight screw plug
25
250
18
Straight screw plug (Reverse restrict pin)
13
130
9
Reverse idler gear shaft lock bolt
29
300
22
Transmission case x Transaxle case
29
300
22
Transmission oil pipe x Transaxle case
17
175
13
Reverse shift arm bracket assembly x Transaxle case
17
175
13
Author:
Date:
211
SS–49
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (E153)
Transmission oil pump assembly x Transaxle case
17
175
13
Transaxle case receiver x Transaxle case
7.4
75
65 in.·lbf
Clutch release fork support
47
480
35
Control lever housing support bracket x Transaxle case
17
175
13
Vehicle speed sensor
17
175
13
Clutch release line bracket x Transaxle case
17
175
13
Back–up light switch
40
410
30
Filler and drain plug
49
500
36
No.1 and No.2 oil receiver pipe x Transmission case
17
175
13
Transmission oil cooler sub–assembly x Elbow
34
350
25
Elbow x Transaxle case
27
275
20
Transmission oil pump case x Oil pump cover
10
105
8
Transaxle case cover x Transaxle case
54
550
40
Differential left case x Differential right case
63
640
46
Ring gear set bolt
124
1,260
91
Author:
Date:
212
SS–50
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
SS09M–01
SERVICE DATA
Input shaft roller bearing journal diameter
Min. 29.970 mm (1.799 in.)
Input shaft 3rd gear journal diameter
Min. 33.090 mm (1.3028 in.)
Input shaft 4th gear journal diameter
Min. 32.470 mm (1.2783 in.)
Input shaft 5th gear journal diameter
Min. 26.970 mm (1.0618 in.)
Input shaft runout
Max.
Output shaft roller bearing journal diameter
Min. 31.970 mm (1.2587 in.)
Output shaft 1st gear journal diameter
Min. 37.970 mm (1.4949 in.)
Output shaft 2nd gear journal diameter
Min. 31.990 mm (1.2594 in.)
Output shaft runout
Max.
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Gear thrust clearance
1st
STD
Max.
0.10 – 0.29 mm (0.0039 – 0.0114 in.)
0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
Gear thrust clearance
2nd
STD
Max.
0.20 – 0.44 mm (0.0079 – 0.0173 in.)
0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
Gear thrust clearance
3rd
STD
Max.
0.10 – 0.25 mm (0.0039 – 0.098 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
Gear thrust clearance
4th
STD
Max.
0.20 – 0.45 mm (0.0079 – 0.0177 in.)
0.50 mm (0.0197 in.)
Gear thrust clearance
5th
STD
Max.
0.20 – 0.40 mm (0.0079 – 0.0157 in.)
0.45 mm (0.0177 in.)
Gear radial clearance
1st, 2nd, 3rd, and 4th
STD
Max.
0.009 – 0.053 mm (0.0004 – 0.0021 in.)
0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
Gear radial clearance
5th
STD
Max.
0.009 – 0.050 mm (0.0004 – 0.0020 in.)
0.070 mm (0.0028 in.)
Max.
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Shift fork to hub sleeve clearance
Synchronizer ring to gear clearance 1st, 3rd and 4th
Min. 0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
Synchronizer ring to gear clearance 2nd
Min. 0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
Differential case side bearing preload (at starting)(For use with SST)
0.8 – 1.6 N·m (8 – 16 kgf·cm, 6.9 – 13.9 in.·lbf)
Differential pinion to side gear backlash
0.05 – 0.20 mm (0.0020 – 0.0079 in.)
Drive in depth
In
Input
ut shaft front oil seal
Reverse restrict pin
in slotted spring
s ring pin
in
Shift and select lever shaft slotted spring pin
0 – 0.5 mm (0 – 0.020 in.)
13.5 ± 0.5 mm (0.531 ± 0.020 in.)
23.5 ± 1.0 mm (0.925 ± 0.039 in.)
Differential side gear thrust washer thickness
0 95 mm (0
0.95
(0.0374
0374 in
in.))
1
1.00
00 mm (0
(0.0394
0394 in
in.))
1 05 mm (0.0413
1.05
(0 0413 in.)
in )
1 10 mm (0.0433
1.10
(0
( 0433 in.)
i )
1.15 mm (0.0453
(
in.))
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
Author:
Date:
213
SS–51
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Input shaft snap ring thickness
No.2 clutch hub
No.3 clutch hub
Rear bearing
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
M k4
Mark
Mark 5
Mark 6
Mark 13
Mark 14
Mark 15
M k 16
Mark
Mark 17
Mark 18
Mark 19
Mark 20
Mark 21
Mark 22
Mark 23
Mark 24
Mark 25
Mark 26
Mark 27
Mark A
Mark B
Mark C
Mark D
Mark E
1.95 – 2.00 mm (0.0768 – 0.0787 in.)
2.00 – 2.05 mm (0.0787
(
– 0.0807 in.))
2.05 – 2.10 mm (0.0807 – 0.0827 in.)
2 10 – 2.15
2.10
2 15 mm (0.0827
(0 0827 – 0.0846
0 0846 in.)
i )
2 15 – 2.20
2.15
2 20 mm (0
(0.0846
0846 – 0.0866
0 0866 in.)
in )
2.20 – 2.25 mm (0.0866 – 0.0886 in.)
2.20 – 2.25 mm (0.0866 – 0.0886 in.)
2.25 – 2.30 mm (0.0886
(
– 0.0906 in.))
2.30 – 2.35 mm (0.0906 – 0.0925 in.)
2 35 – 2.40
2.35
2 40 mm (0.0925
(0 0925 – 0.0945
0 0945 in.)
i )
2 40 – 2
2.40
2.45
45 mm (0
(0.0945
0945 – 0
0.0965
0965 in
in.))
2.45 – 2.50 mm (0.0965 – 0.0984 in.)
2.50 – 2.55 mm (0.0984 – 0.01004 in.)
2.55 – 2.60 mm (0.1004
(
– 0.01024 in.))
2.60 – 2.65 mm (0.1024 – 0.01043 in.)
2 65 – 2.70
2.65
2 70 mm (0.1043
(0 1043 – 0.01063
0 01063 in.)
in )
2 70 – 2.75
2.70
2 75 mm (0.1063
(0 1063 – 0.01083
0 01083 in
in.))
2.75 – 2.80 mm (0.1083 – 0.01102 in.)
2.80 – 2.85 mm (0.1102 – 0.01122 in.)
2.85 – 2.90 mm (0.1122 – 0.01142 in.)
2.90 – 2.95 mm (0.1142 – 0.01161 in.)
2 15 – 2
2.15
2.20
20 mm (0
(0.0846
0846 – 0
0.0866
0866 in
in.))
2 20 – 2.25
2.20
2 25 mm (0
(0.0866
0866 – 0.0886
0 0886 in
in.))
2.25 – 2.30 mm (0.0886 – 0.0906 in.)
2.30 – 2.35 mm (0.0906 – 0.0925 in.)
2.35 – 2.40 mm (0.0925 – 0.0945 in.)
Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
Mark 4
Mark 5
Mark 6
Mark 7
Mark 8
Mark 9
Mark 10
Mark 11
Mark 12
Mark 13
Mark 14
Mark 15
Mark 16
Mark 17
Mark 18
M k 19
Mark
1.90
1
90 mm (0.0748
(0 0748 in.)
in )
1 95 mm (0
1.95
(0.0768
0768 in
in.))
2
2.00
00 mm (0
(0.0787
0787 in
in.))
2
2.05
05 mm (0
(0.0807
0807 in
in.))
2.10 mm (0.0827 in.)
2.15 mm (0.0846 in.)
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
2.25 mm (0.0886 in.)
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
2.35 mm (0.0925 in.)
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
2.45 mm (0.0965 in.)
2.50 mm (0.0984
(
in.))
2.55 mm (0.1004
(
in.))
2.60 mm (0.1024
(
in.))
2.65 mm (0.1043 in.)
2.70 mm (0.1063 in.)
2.75 mm (0.1083 in.)
2.80 mm ((0.1102 iin.))
Differential side bearing adjusting shim thickness
Author:
Date:
214
SS–52
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
SS09N–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
64
46
650
470
47
34
Cruise control actuator x Body (w/ Cruise control)
13
130
9
Starter x Transaxle
37
378
28
Clutch release cylinder x Transaxle
12
120
9
Bolt A
Bolt B
12
6.9
120
70
9
61 in.·lbf
Manifold stay
Front side
42
425
31
Manifold stay
Rear side
Transaxle x Engine
Clutch line bracket x Transaxle
(See page MX–4)
17 mm head
14 mm head
39
400
29
103
1,050
76
19
33
195
330
14
24
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
62
630
46
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
No.1 exhaust pipe support bracket x Front suspension member
33
330
24
Stabilizer bar link x Stabilizer bar
39
400
29
Stabilizer bar bracket x Front suspension member
19
195
14
PS gear assembly x Front suspension member
181
1,850
134
44
66
450
670
33
48
LH engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
80
820
59
LH engine mounting bracket x Transaxle
64
650
47
Rear engine mounting insulator x Front suspension member
66
670
48
Steering return pipe x Front suspension member
10
100
7
181
32
36
1,850
330
370
134
24
27
37
380
27
RH stiffener plate
39
400
29
Rear end plate
9.3
95
82 in.·lbf
Shift cable grommet retainer x Body
4.9
50
43 in.·lbf
Shift lever assembly x Body
12
120
9
Transmission case x Transaxle case
29
300
22
Transmission case x Case cover
29
300
22
Transmission case protector
18
185
13
Rear bearing retainer
42
430
31
Output shaft front bearing lock plate
18
185
13
Front wheel
Exhaust pipe
i e bracket
Front engine mounting insulator x Front sus
suspension
ension member
Front suspension
sus ension member with lower suspension
sus ension arm
(See page MX–4)
LH stiffener plate
Bolt
Nut
Silver bolt
Green bolt
Bolt A
Bolt B
Nut C
Transaxle case receiver set bolt
7.4
75
65 in.·lbf
5th driven gear lock nut
123
1,250
90
Reverse idler shaft lock bolt
29
300
22
Control shaft cover
37
375
27
Control shift lever x Lever shaft
6.4
65
56 in.·lbf
Ring gear x Differential case
83
850
61
Selecting bellcrank x Transmission case
37
380
27
Author:
Date:
215
SS–53
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
MANUAL TRANSAXLE (S51)
Engine mount bracket x Transaxle
52
530
38
Reverse shift arm bracket
18
185
13
No.3 shift fork x Shift fork shaft
18
185
13
Lock ball assembly
29
300
22
Filler and Drain plugs
49
500
36
Back–up light switch
44
450
33
Differential side bearing retainer
18
185
13
Release bearing retainer
7.4
75
65 in.·lbf
Straight screw plug
13
130
9
Vehicle speed sensor driven gear
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Clutch release fork support
39
400
29
Author:
Date:
216
SS–54
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
SS0AS–01
SERVICE DATA
Line pressure (Wheel locked)
Engine idling
D position
R position
at stall (Throttle valve fully opened)
D position
R position
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
Engine idle speed
D and R positions
N → D position
N → R position
A/C OFF and N range
Throttle cable adjustment
(Throttle valve fully opened)
Drive plate runout
Torque converter runout
Torque converter installation distance
Differential oil seal drive in depth
Shift point
D position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
(Throttle valve fully closed)
2 position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
L position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
363 – 422 kPa (3.7 – 4.3 kgf/cm2, 53 – 61 psi)
618 – 794 kPa (6.3 – 8.1 kgf/cm2, 90 – 115 psi)
735 – 862 kPa (7.5 – 8.8 kgf/cm2, 107 – 125 psi)
1,373 – 1,608 kPa (14.0 – 16.4 kgf/cm2, 199 – 233 psi)
2,450 ± 150 rpm
Less than 1.2 seconds
Less than 1.5 seconds
750 ± 50 rpm
Between boot end face and inner cable stopper
0 – 1 mm (0 – 0.04 in.)
Max.
Max.
LH side
RH side
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
More than 13.0 mm (0.512 in.)
2.7 ± 0.5 mm (0.106 ± 0.020 in.)
0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.020 in.)
1→2
2→3
3 → O/D
O/D → 3
3→2
2→1
O/D → 3
3 → O/D
58 – 63 km/h (36 – 39 mph)
109 – 117 km/h (68 – 73 mph)
145 – 151 km/h (90 – 94 mph)
138 – 146 km/h (86 – 91 mph)
100 – 108 km/h (62 – 67 mph)
51 – 56 km/h (32 – 35 mph)
38 – 43 km/h (24 – 27 mph)
18 – 22 km/h (11 – 14 mph)
1→2
3→2
2→1
58 – 63 km/h (36 – 39 mph)
106 – 114 km/h (66 – 71 mph)
51 – 56 km/h (32 – 35 mph)
2→1
47 – 51 km/h (29 – 32 mph)
*1: The maximum vehicle speed for manual shift down when shifting down
from D to 2.
*2: The maximum vehicle speed for manual shift down when shifting down
from 2 to L.
Lock–up point (Throttle valve fully opened)
D position
3rd Gear (O/D main switch OFF)
Lock–up ON
Lock–up OFF
67 – 72 km/h (42 – 45 mph)
64 – 69 km/h (40 – 43 mph)
Lock–up ON
Lock–up OFF
67 – 72 km/h (42 – 45 mph)
64 – 69 km/h (40 – 43 mph)
O/D gear
Author:
Date:
217
SS–55
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
SS0AT–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Transaxle x Starter
42
430
31
Transaxle x Rear end plate
25
250
18
Transaxle x No.1 exhaust pipe support bracket
19
195
14
Transaxle x Engine
66
670
48
Torque converter clutch x Drive plate
27
280
20
Body x Front lower brace
Bolt
Nut
181
36
1,850
370
134
27
Body x Rear lower brace
19 mm head bolt
14 mm head bolt
Nut
181
32
36
1,850
330
370
134
24
27
Front suspension member x FR engine mounting
TMC made
TMMK made: Green color bolt
TMMK made: Silver color bolt
80
66
44
820
670
450
59
48
32
Front suspension member x RR engine mounting
66
670
48
Front suspension member x LH engine mounting
80
820
59
Transaxle x LH engine mounting
64
650
47
Front suspension member x Steering return pipe mounting bracket
10
100
7
Front suspension member x Stabilizer bar bracket
19
195
14
Stabilizer bar x Stabilizer bar link
39
400
29
Ball joint x Lower suspension arm
127
1,300
94
Steering gear housing set bolt x Nut
181
1,850
134
Exhaust manifold x Front exhaust pipe
62
630
46
Front suspension member x Exhaust pipe No.1 support bracket
33
330
24
Front exhaust pipe x Center exhaust pipe
56
570
41
No.1 exhaust pipe support bracket x Exhaust pipe clamp
33
330
24
Axle hub nut
294
3,000
217
Steering knuckle x Tie rod end
49
500
36
Vehicle speed sensor x Transaxle
16
160
12
5.4
6.9
55
70
48 in.·lbf
61 in.·lbf
Park/neutral position switch x Control shaft lever
13
130
9
Control shaft lever x Control cable
15
150
11
Oil pan x Drain plug
49
500
36
Oil pan x Transaxle
4.9
50
43 in.·lbf
Valve body x Manual valve body
10
100
7
Valve body x Transaxle
10
100
7
Drive shaft center bearing lock bolt
32
330
24
Park/neutral position switch x Transaxle
Bolt
Nut
Stiffener plate
Front side
Rear side
42
39
430
400
31
29
Exhaust manifold stay
Front side
Rear side
42
39
430
400
31
29
Author:
Date:
218
SS–56
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
SS0BL–01
SERVICE DATA
Line pressure (wheel locked)
Engine idling
D position
R position
at stall (Throttle valve fully opened)
D position
R position
1,138 – 1,236 kPa (11.6 – 12.6 kgf/cm2, 165 – 179 psi)
1,716 – 1,854 kPa (17.5 – 18.9 kgf/cm2, 249 – 269 psi)
2,600 ± 150 rpm
Engine stall revolution
Time lag
401 – 461 kPa (4.1 – 4.7 kgf/cm2, 58 – 66 psi)
804 – 882 kPa (8.2 – 9.0 kgf/cm2, 117 – 128 psi)
N → D position
N → R position
Less than 1.2 seconds
Less than 1.5 seconds
Engine idle speed (A/C OFF)
N position
Throttle cable adjustment (Throttle valve fully opened)
Drive plate runout
Torque converter clutch runout
Torque converter clutch installation distance
Between boot and face and inner cable stopper
0 – 1 mm (0 – 0.04 in.)
Max.
Max.
Lock–up point
(Throttle valve opening 5%)
3rd gear (O/D main switch OFF)
Lock–up ON
Lock–up OFF
O/D gear
Lock–up ON
Lock–up OFF
Shift schedule
D position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
(Throttle valve fully closed)
2 position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
L position
(Throttle valve fully opened)
700 ± 50 rpm
1→2
2→3
3 → O/D
O/D → 3
3→2
2→1
3 → O/D
O/D → 3
0.3 mm (0.0118 in.)
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
More than 13.7 mm (0.539 in.)
60 – 65 km/h (37 – 40 mph)
53 – 58 km/h (33 – 36 mph)
60 – 64 km/h (37 – 40 mph)
53 – 58 km/h (33 – 36 mph)
60 – 66 km/h (37 – 41 mph)
112 – 121 km/h (70 – 75 mph)
174 – 183 km/h (108 – 114 mph)
167 – 176 km/h (104 – 109 mph)
104 – 112 km/h (65 – 70 mph)
50 – 55 km/h (31 – 34 mph)
35 – 40 km/h (22 – 25 mph)
20 – 25 km/h (12 – 16 mph)
1→2
3→2
2→1
60 – 66 km/h (37 – 41 mph)
122 – 130 km/h (76 – 81 mph)
50 – 55 km/h (31 – 34 mph)
3→2
2→1
106 – 115 km/h (66 – 71 mph)
54 – 59 km/h (34 – 37 mph)
Author:
Date:
219
SS–57
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
SS0BM–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
80
820
59
66
44
670
450
48
32
Rear engine mounting insulator x Front frame assembly
80
820
59
LH transaxle mounting insulator x Transaxle
64
650
47
Engine mounting absorber x Front frame assembly
48
490
35
Front engine front mounting insulator x Front frame assembly
TMC:
TMMK:
Green color bolt
Silver color bolt
Transaxle x Engine
17 mm bolt
66
670
48
Transaxle x Engine
12 mm bolt
48
490
35
Torque converter clutch x Drive plate
41
420
30
Valve body x Transaxle case
11
110
8
Oil strainer x Valve body
11
110
8
Oil pan x Transaxle case
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
Oil pan drain plug
49
500
36
Park/Neutral position switch x Transaxle case (bolt)
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Park/Neutral position switch (nut)
6.9
70
61 in.·lbf
B3 apply pipe retainer
11
110
8
Connector clamp
11
110
8
Manual valve body x Transaxle case
11
110
8
Detent spring x Manual valve body
11
110
8
Oil pipe bracket
10
100
7
Steering gear housing x Front suspension member
181
1,850
134
Stabilizer bar bracket
19
195
14
Vehicle speed sensor x Transaxle case
4.9
50
43 in.·lbf
Direct clutch speed sensor x Transaxle case
11
110
8
Transfer lubrication apply pipe retainer
11
110
8
Exhaust manifold bracket x Transaxle case
Except California
California
20
34
200
350
14
25
Exhaust manifold plate
Except California
California
20
34
200
350
14
25
Front frame x Body
19 mm
181
1,850
134
Front frame x Body
14 mm
32
330
24
Front frame x Body
Nut
36
370
27
Exhaust front pipe x Exhaust center pipe
56
570
41
Exhaust manifold x Exhaust front pipe
62
630
46
Exhaust front pipe support stay x Exhaust front pipe support bracket
33
330
24
Exhaust pipe support x Front frame
33
330
24
Starter x Torque converter clutch housing
39
400
29
Transaxle control shaft lever x Park/neutral position switch
15
150
11
Throttle cable adjusting nut
15
150
11
Drive plate x Crankshaft
83
850
61
Shift control cable x Transaxle control shaft lever
15
150
11
Throttle cable retaining plate set bolt
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Shift solenoid valve No.1, No.2, SL, SLN x Valve body
6.6
67
58 in.·lbf
Author:
Date:
220
SS–58
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Front wheel nut
103
1,050
76
Exhaust front pipe support bracket x Body
21
210
15
PS reseroir pipe x Front frame
10
100
7
Engine hood x Hood hinge
26
265
19
Author:
Date:
221
SS–59
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SS04W–01
SERVICE DATA
P195/70R14 90S
Cold tire inflation
pressure
(Normal driving)
P205/65R15 92H
P195/70R14 90S
Cold tire inflation
pressure
(Trailer towing)
Front, Rear*1
210 kPa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
Front, Rear*2
210 kPa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
Front, Rear*1
220 kPa (2.2 kgf/cm2, 32 psi)
Front, Rear*2
200 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2, 29 psi)
Front, Rear*3
210 kPa (2.1 kgf/cm2, 30 psi)
Front, Rear*4
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2, 35 psi)
Rear*3
220 kPa (2.2 kgf/cm2, 32 psi)
Front, Rear*4
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2, 35 psi)
Front,
P205/65R15 92H
V hi l h
Vehicle
height
i ht
195/70R14
205/65R15
Camber
5S – FE
1MZ – FE
Left – right error
Caster
5S – FE
1MZ – FE
Front wheel
alignment
Left – right error
Steering axis inclination
5S – FE
1MZ – FE
Left – right error
Toe–in (Total)
Front*5
212 mm (8.35 in.)
Rear*6
264 mm (10.39 in.)
Front*5
215 mm (8.46 in.)
Rear*6
266 mm (10.49 in.)
–0 36 ± 45
–0°36’
45’ (0.6
(0.6° ± 0.75°)
0.75 )
–0°37’
–0
37 ± 45’
45 (0.62
(0.62° ± 0.75°)
0.75 )
45’ (0.75°) or less
2°10’ ± 45’ (2.17° ± 0.75°)
2°11’ ± 45’ (2.18° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
13°01’ ± 45’ (13.02° ± 0.75°)
13°04’ ± 45’ (13.07° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
0° ± 12’ (0° ± 0.2°)
0 ± 2 mm (0 ± 0.08 in.)
Rack end length difference 1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
37°12’ ± 2° (37.2° ± 2°)
Inside wheel
Wh l angle
Wheel
l
195/70R14
32°21’ (32.45°)
Outside wheel
35°47’ ± 2° (35.78° ± 2°)
Inside wheel
205/65R15
Camber
Rear wheel
alignment
li
t
5S – FE
1MZ – FE
Left – right error
Toe–in (Total)
31°25’ (31.42°)
Outside wheel
–0°42’ ± 45’ (–0.7° ± 0.75°)
–0°45’ ± 45’ (–0.75° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
0°24’ ± 12’ (0.4° ± 0.2°)
4 ± 2 mm (0.16 ± 0.08 in.)
No.2 lower suspension arm length difference 1 mm (0.04 in.) or less
*1: For all loads including rated loads
*2: For reduced loads (1 to 4 passengers)
*3: For driving under 160 km/h (100 mph)
*4: For driving at 160 km/h (100 mph) or over
*5: Front measuring point
Measure from the ground to the center of the front side lower suspension arm mounting bolt.
*6: Rear measuring point
Measure from the ground to the center of the strut rod mounting bolt.
Author:
Date:
222
SS–60
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
F t axle
Front
l
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Axle hub deviation
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
1MZ – FE (M/T)
1MZ – FE (A/T)
F t suspension
Front
i
R
Rear
axle
l
R
Rear
suspension
i
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
Axle bearing backlash
Drive shaft standard length
5S – FE
Front drive shaft
–
LH
RH
LH
RH
LH
RH
609.2 ± 2.0 mm (23.984 ± 0.079 in.)
867.3 ± 2.0 mm (34.146 ± 0.079 in.)
601.5 ± 2.0 mm (23.681 ± 0.079 in.)
871.6 ± 2.0 mm (34.315 ± 0.079 in.)
586.0 ± 2.0 mm (23.071 ± 0.079 in.)
881.6 ± 2.0 mm (34.709 ± 0.079 in.)
Lower ball joint turning torque
1.0 – 3.4 N·m (10 – 35 kgf·cm, 8.7 – 30 in.·lbf)
Stabilizer bar link turning torque
0.05 – 1.0 N·m (0.5 – 10 kgf·cm, 0.4 – 8.7 in.·lbf)
Axle bearing backlash
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Axle hub deviation
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
No.2 lower suspension arm length
512.3 mm (20.169 in.)
Stabilizer bar link turning torque
0.05 – 1.0 N·m (0.5 – 10 kgf·cm, 0.4 – 8.7 in.·lbf)
Author:
Date:
223
SS–61
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SS04X–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Hub nut
103
1,050
76
Tie rod end lock nut
74
750
54
Steering knuckle x Shock absorber
211
2,150
156
Steering knuckle x Brake caliper
107
1,090
79
Steering knuckle x Tie rod end
49
500
36
Axle hub x Drive shaft
294
3,000
217
Lower ball joint x Lower suspension arm
127
1,300
94
Lower ball joint x Steering knuckle
123
1,250
90
Steering knuckle x Disc brake dust cover
8.3
85
74 in.·lbf
Drive shaft center bearing lock bolt
32
330
24
Suspension support x Body
80
820
59
Suspension support x Piston rod
49
500
36
ABS speed sensor set bolt
8.0
82
71 in.·lbf
Flexible hose and ABS speed sensor wire harness x Shock absorber
29
300
22
Lower suspension arm set bolt
206
2,100
152
Stabilizer bar bracket x Suspension member
19
195
14
Stabilizer bar link set bolt
39
400
29
Hub nut
103
1,050
76
No.2 lower suspension arm lock nut
56
570
41
Brake caliper x Rear axle carrier
47
475
34
Axle hub bearing set bolt
80
820
59
255
196
2,600
2,000
188
145
Flexible hose x Shock absorber
29
300
22
ABS speed sensor set bolt
8.0
82
71 in.·lbf
ABS speed sensor wire harness x Shock absorber
5.5
56
49 in.·lbf
Rear side seatback set bolt
18
185
13
Suspension support x Body
39
400
29
Suspension support x Piston rod
49
500
36
Exhaust center pipe set nut
56
570
41
Parking brake cable set bolt
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Lower suspension arm x Suspension member
181
1,850
134
Lower suspension arm x Rear axle carrier
181
1,850
134
Strut rod x Body
113
1,150
83
Strut rod x Rear axle carrier
113
1,150
83
Suspension member x Body
51
520
38
Suspension member lower stopper sub–assembly x Body
38
390
28
Stabilizer bar bracket x Suspension member
19
195
14
Stabiliser bar link set nut
39
400
29
FRONT:
REAR:
Shock absorber x Rear axle carrier
New nut
Reused nut (apply engine oil the threads)
Author:
Date:
224
SS–62
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
BRAKE
BRAKE
SS09X–01
SERVICE DATA
Brake pedal height (from asphalt sheet)
152.0 – 162.0 mm (5.984 – 6.378 in.)
Brake pedal freeplay
1 – 6 mm (0.04 – 0.24 in.)
Brake pedal reserve distance at 490 N (50 kgf, 110.2 lbf)
More than 70 mm (2.76 in.)
Brake booster push rod to piston clearance (w/SST)
0 mm (0 in.)
Front brake pad thickness (5S–FE engine)
STD
12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
Front brake pad thickness (1MZ–FE engine)
STD
11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Front brake pad thickness
Front brake disc thickness
Minimum 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
STD
28.0 mm (1.102 in.)
Front brake disc thickness
Minimum 26.0 mm (1.024 in.)
Front brake disc runout
Maximum 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear brake drum inside diameter
Rear brake drum inside diameter
Rear brake shoe lining thickness
Rear brake shoe lining thickness
STD
Maximum 230.6 mm (9.079 in.)
STD
Rear brake pad thickness
Rear brake disc thickness
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
Minimum 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Rear brake drum to shoe clearance
Rear brake pad thickness
228.6 mm (9.000 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
STD
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Minimum 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
STD
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
Rear brake disc thickness
Minimum 9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
Rear brake disc runout
Maximum 0.15 mm (0.0059 in.)
Rear brake disc inside diameter
Rear brake disc inside diameter
Parking brake lining thickness for rear disc brake
Parking brake lining thickness for rear disc brake
STD
170 mm (6.69 in.)
Maximum 171 mm (6.73 in.)
STD
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
Minimum 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Parking brake lever travel at 196 N (20 kgf, 44 lbf)
5 – 8 clicks
Parking brake clearance between rear shoe and lever
Less than 0.35 mm (0.0138 in.)
Parking brake adjusting shim thickness for rear disc brake
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
0.9 mm (0.035 in.)
Author:
Date:
225
SS–63
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
BRAKE
SS09Y–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Master cylinder x Piston stopper bolt
10
100
7
Master cylinder x Reservoir
1.7
18
16 in.·lbf
Master cylinder x Brake booster
13
130
9
10 mm nut
15
155
11
12 mm nut
20
200
14
Brake booster clevis lock nut
25
260
19
Brake booster x Pedal bracket
13
130
9
Brake pedal x Pedal bracket
39
400
29
Pedal bracket x Instrument panel reinforcement
13
130
9
Front brake caliper installation bolt
34
350
25
Brake line union nut
Bleeder plug
8.3
85
74 in.·lbf
Front brake torque plate x Steering knuckle
107
1,090
79
Front brake caliper x Flexible hose
29
300
21
Flexible hose x Shock absorber bracket
29
300
21
Rear drum brake wheel cylinder x Backing plate
10
100
7
Parking brake cable bracket x Backing plate
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
Rear brake caliper installation bolt
20
200
14
Rear disc brake cariper main pin installation bolt
26
270
20
Rear brake caliper x Flexible hose
29
300
21
Rear brake torque plate x Rear axle carrier
47
475
34
Proportioning valve installation bolt
8.8
90
78 in.·lbf
ABS actuator x Actuator bracket
DENSO type
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
ABS actuator x Actuator bracket
BOSCH type
9.0
92
80 in.·lbf
ABS actuator x ECU
BOSCH type
2.6
27
23 in.·lbf
ABS & TRAC actuator x Actuator bracket
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
ABS (& TRAC) actuator bracket x Body
19
195
14
Front speed sensor installation bolt
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
Front speed sensor harness clamp bolt
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Rear speed sensor installation bolt
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
Rear speed sensor harness clamp bolt
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Author:
Date:
226
SS–64
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STEERING
STEERING
SS06L–03
SERVICE DATA
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
Steering wheel freeplay
Maximum 30 mm (1.18 in.)
5S–FE Engine :
Drive belt tension
New belt
95 – 145 lbf
Drive belt tension
Used belt
60 – 100 lbf
Drive belt tension
New belt
150 – 185 lbf
Drive belt tension
Used belt
95 – 135 lbf
1MZ–FE Engine :
Fluid level rise
Maximum 5 mm (0.20 in.)
Minimum 7,845 kPa (80 kgf/cm2, 1,138 psi)
Fluid pressure at idle speed with valve closed
Steering effort at idle speed
Maximum 5.9 N·m (60 kgf·cm, 52 in.·lbf)
PS VANE PUMP
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Vane pump rotating torque
Maximum 0.3 N·m (2.8 kgf·cm, 2.4 in.·lbf)
Oil clearance between pump shaft and bushing
Oil clearance between pump shaft and bushing
STD
0.03 – 0.05 mm (0.0012 – 0.0020 in.)
Maximum 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Vane plate height
Minimum 8.6 mm (0.339 in.)
Vane plate thickness
Minimum 1.397 mm (0.0550 in.)
Vane plate length
Minimum 14.991 mm (0.5902 in.)
Clearance between the rotor groove and plate
Vane plate length
Spring free length
Maximum 0.035 mm (0.0014 in.)
Pump rotor and cam ring mark
NONE
14.999 – 15.001 mm (0.59051 – 0.59059 in.)
1
14.997 – 14.999 mm (0.59043 – 0.59051 in.)
2
14.995 – 14.997 mm (0.59035 – 0.59043 in.)
3
14.993 – 14.995 mm (0.59027 – 0.59035 in.)
4
14.991 – 14.993 mm (0.59020 – 0.59027 in.)
Minimum 32.3 mm (1.272 in.)
PS GEAR
Steering rack runout
Total preload (Control valve rotating torque)
Maximum 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
0.8 – 1.4 N·m (8 – 14 kgf·cm, 6.9 – 12.2 in.·lbf)
Author:
Date:
227
SS–65
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STEERING
SS06M–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
STEERING COLUMN
Steering wheel pad set screw (Torx screw)
7.1
72
63 in.·lbf
Steering wheel set nut
35
360
26
Intermediate shaft assembly x Control valve shaft
35
360
26
Steering column assembly x Intermediate shaft assembly
35
360
26
Steering column assembly set nut
25
260
19
Turn signal bracket x Column tube
7
70
61 in.·lbf
Lower column tube attachment x Column tube
19
195
14
5S–FE Engine
32 (25)
326 (250)
24 (18)
1MZ–FE Engine
20 (25)
203 (250)
15 (18)
PS VANE PUMP
5S–FE and 1MZ–FE Engines:
Pressure feed tube x Control valve housing
Pressure feed tube x Pressure feed tube
Clamp plate set nut
5S–FE Engine
10
100
7
Clamp plate set nut
1MZ–FE Engine
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
PS vane pump set bolt
A bolt
29 (43)
293 (440)
21 (32)
PS vane pump set bolt
B bolt
43
440
32
Oil pressure switch x Union bolt
21
210
15
Union bolt x Pressure feed tube
52
525
38
Vane pump pulley set nut
43
440
32
Front bracket x Rear bracket
43
440
32
Suction port union set bolt
13
130
9
Pressure port union
83
850
62
Rear housing set bolt
24
240
17
10
100
7
32 (25)
326 (250)
24 (18)
19
195
14
PS GEAR
Pressure feed tube clamp plate set nut
Pressure feed and return tubes x Control valve housing
Stabilizer bar set bolt
PS gear assembly set bolt and nut
181
1,850
134
10 (13)
102 (130)
7 (9)
74
750
54
Rack x Rack end
60 (83)
615 (850)
45 (62)
Rack guide spring cap lock nut
50 (69)
513 (700)
37 (51)
Rack housing cap
59
600
43
Selt–locking nut
25
250
18
Control valve housing set bolt
18
185
13
Turn pressure tube union nut
Tie rod end lock nut
( ): For use without SST
Author:
Date:
228
SS–66
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SS061–17
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Steering wheel
35
360
26
Steering wheel pad
7.1
72
63 in.·lbf
Front passenger airbag assembly x Instrument panel reinforcement
20
205
15
37
375
27
18
15
185
150
13
11
Airbag sensor assembly
20
205
15
Front airbag sensor
20
205
15
Side airbag sensor assembly
20
205
15
7.5
42
76
430
66 in.·lbf
31
Front seat installation bolt
Seatback frame set bolt
(See page RS–49)
Front seat outer belt retractor
Bolt A
Bolt B
Upper bolt
Lower bolt
Author:
Date:
229
SS–67
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
BODY ELECTRICAL
SS0B0–05
SERVICE DATA
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
Flashes/ Minute
60 – 120
SPEEDOMETER (ON–VEHICLE)
USA:
Standard indication (mph)
Allowable range (mph)
20
18 – 24
40
38 – 44
60
56 – 66
80
78 – 88
100
98 – 110
120
118 – 132
Standard indication (km/h)
Allowable range (km/h)
20
17 – 24
40
38 – 46
60
57.5 – 67
80
77 – 88
100
96 – 109
120
115 – 130
140
134 – 151.5
160
153 – 173
CANADA:
TACHOMETER (ON–VEHICLE)/ DC 13.5 V 25 °C at (77 °F)
Standard indication
Allowable range
700
630 – 770
1,000
900 – 1,100
2,000
1,850 – 2,150
3,000
2,800 – 3,200
4,000
3,800 – 4,200
5,000
4,800 – 5,200
6,000
5,750 – 6,250
7,000
6,700 – 7,300
A–B
Approx. 126.2 Ω
A–C
Approx. 280.5 Ω
B–C
Approx. 154.3 Ω
Float position mm (in.)
Resistance (Ω)
F: Approx. –91.1 (–3.587)
Approx. 3.0
1/2: Approx. –34.2 (–1.346)
Approx. 31.7
E: Approx. 30.8 (1.213)
Approx. 110.0
FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE
FUEL SENDER GAUGE
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE (Resistance)
A–B
Approx. 175.7 Ω
A–C
Approx. 54.0 Ω
Author:
Date:
230
SS–68
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
Approx. 229.7 Ω
B–C
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENDER GAUGE (Resistance)
Temperature °C (°F)
Resistance (Ω)
50 (122.0)
274
120 (248.0)
26.4
Author:
Date:
231
SS–69
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
BODY
BODY
SS0BY–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
–
–
–
Front bumper cover x Body
5.5
55
49 in.·lbf
Front bumper reinforcement x Body
34
350
25
FRONT BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
–
–
–
Rear bumper cover x Body
5.0
50
43 in.·lbf
Rear bumper reinforcement x Body
34
350
25
–
–
–
Hood hinge x Hood
26
260
19
Hood lock x Body
8.0
80
71 in.·lbf
FRONT AND REAR DOOR
–
–
–
Front door hinge x Body
31
310
22
Rear door hinge x Body
26
260
19
Door hinge x Door panel
26
260
19
Door lock striker x Body
26
260
19
Outside rear view mirror x Front door panel
5.5
55
49
Door inside handle x Door panel
3.5
35
31 in.·lbf
Door glass x Window regulator
8.0
80
71 in.·lbf
Window regulator x Door panel
5.5
55
49 in.·lbf
Door lock x Door panel
5.0
50
43 in.·lbf
Door outside handle x Door panel
7.0
70
61 in.·lbf
Door check x Body
30
300
22
Door check x Door panel
8.0
80
71 in.·lbf
–
–
–
Luggage door hinge x Luggage door
8.0
80
71 in.·lbf
Luggage door lock striker x Body
5.5
55
49 in.·lbf
Luggage door lock x Luggage door
5.5
55
49 in.·lbf
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER
–
–
–
Wiper motor assembly x Body
24
245
18
Wiper arm x Wiper pivot
5.5
55
49 in.·lbf
HOOD
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
SLIDING ROOF
–
–
–
5.5
55
49 in.·lbf
–
–
–
Front passenger airbag assembly x Reinforcement
20
200
14
Steering wheel lock nut
35
360
26
SEAT
–
–
–
Front Seat (Power Seat for TMC Made)
–
–
–
Hinge cover x Seatback frame
18
185
13
Seatback frame x Power seat adjuster
15
150
11
Seatback frame x Side airbag assembly
6.0
61
53 in.·lbf
–
–
–
37
375
27
Sliding roof assembly x Body
INSTRUMENT PANEL
Front Seat (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
Front seat adjuster x Body
Author:
Date:
232
SS–70
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
BODY
Front seat inner upper track x Seat cushion
18
185
13
Side Airbag assembly x Seatback frame
18
185
13
Seatback assembly x Seat cushion frame
6.0
61
53 in.·lbf
–
–
–
6.0
61
53 in.·lbf
–
–
–
6.0
61
53 in.·lbf
–
–
–
18
185
13
17.5
178
12.5
–
–
–
Seatback pad (RH bolt) x Body
7.8
79
69 in.·lbf
Seatback pad (center bolt) x Body
42
428
31
Child restraint seat x Body
13
130
9
Seatback hinge x Body
18
185
13
17.5
178
12.5
SEAT BELT
–
–
–
Front Seat belt
–
–
–
Shoulder anchor x Adjustable anchor
42
420
31
Adjustable anchor x Body
42
420
31
Inner belt x Seat
42
420
31
Retractor x Body
7.8
79
69 in.·lbf
Floor anchor x Body
42
420
31
–
–
–
Lap outer belt anchor x Body
42
420
31
ELR x Body
42
420
31
Inner belt x Body
42
420
31
Center belt x Body
42
420
31
Front Seat (Power Seat for TMMK Made)
Side airbag assembly x Seat cushion frame
Front Seat (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
Side airbag assembly x Seat cushion frame
Rear Seat (TMC Made)
Seatback hinge x Body
Rear seatback lock control x Rear seatback frame
Rear Seat (TMMK Made)
Rear seatback lock control x Rear seatback frame
Rear Seat Belt
Author:
Date:
233
SS–71
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
SS05V–02
SERVICE DATA
800 ± 50 g (28.22 ± 1.76 oz.)
Refrigerant charge volume
Drive belt tension
–
New belt
165 ± 26 lbf
Used belt
110 ± 11 lbf
Idle–up speed
Magnetic clutch clearance
–
Magnetic clutch not engaged
700 ± 50 rpm
Magnetic clutch engaged
700 ± 50 rpm
0.5 ± 0.15 mm (0.020 ± 0.0059 in.)
Author:
Date:
234
SS–72
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
AIR CONDITIONING
SS05W–06
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Compressor x Discharge hose
10
100
7
Compressor x Suction hose
10
100
7
Condenser x Disaharge hose
10
100
7
Condenser x Liquid tube
14
140
10
Receiver x Liquid tube
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Expansion valve x Evaporator
5.4
55
48in.·lbf
Compressor x Engine
25
250
18
Compressor x Compressor bracket (1MZ–FE Only)
25
250
18
Drive belt adjusting bar bracket x Compressor
25
250
18
Drive belt adjusting bar bracket x Adjusting bar
18
185
13
Pivot bolt
52
520
38
56
570
41
Adjusting lock bolt
18
185
13
Pressure switch x Liquied tube
10
100
7
Pressure plate x Compressor
13.2
135
9
Suction line (Piping joint)
32
330
24
Suction line (Block joint)
10
100
7
5S
5S–FE
FE
1MZ–FE
Author:
Date:
235
SS–1
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STANDARD BOLT
STANDARD BOLT
SS0ZS–01
HOW TO DETERMINE BOLT STRENGTH
Bolt Type
Hexagon Head Bolt
Normal Recess Bolt
Deep Recess Bolt
Stud Bolt
Weld Bolt
4
Class
4T
No Mark
No Mark
No Mark
5
5T
6
6T
w/ Washer
w/ Washer
7
7T
8
8T
9
9T
10
10T
11
11T
B06431
Author:
Date:
59
SS–2
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STANDARD BOLT
SS0ZT–01
SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR STANDARD BOLTS
Specified torque
Class
Diameter
mm
Pitch
mm
Hexagon head bolt
Hexagon flange bolt
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
4T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
5
12.5
26
47
74
115
55
130
260
480
760
1,150
48 in.·lbf
9
19
35
55
83
6
14
29
53
84
–
60
145
290
540
850
–
52 in.·lbf
10
21
39
61
–
5T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
6.5
15.5
32
59
91
140
65
160
330
600
930
1,400
56 in.·lbf
12
24
43
67
101
7.5
17.5
36
65
100
–
75
175
360
670
1,050
–
65 in.·lbf
13
26
48
76
–
6T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
8
19
39
71
110
170
80
195
400
730
1,100
1,750
69 in.·lbf
14
29
53
80
127
9
21
44
80
125
–
90
210
440
810
1,250
–
78 in.·lbf
15
32
59
90
–
7T
6
8
10
12
14
16
1
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.5
1.5
10.5
25
52
95
145
230
110
260
530
970
1,500
2,300
8
19
38
70
108
166
12
28
58
105
165
–
120
290
590
1,050
1,700
–
9
21
43
76
123
–
8T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
29
61
110
300
620
1,100
22
45
80
33
68
120
330
690
1,250
24
50
90
9T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
34
70
125
340
710
1,300
25
51
94
37
78
140
380
790
1,450
27
57
105
10T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
38
78
140
390
800
1,450
28
58
105
42
88
155
430
890
1,600
31
64
116
11T
8
10
12
1.25
1.25
1.25
42
87
155
430
890
1,600
31
64
116
47
97
175
480
990
1,800
35
72
130
SS–3
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
STANDARD BOLT
SS0ZU–01
HOW TO DETERMINE NUT STRENGTH
Nut Type
Present Standard
Hexagon Nut
Old Standard Hexagon Nut
Cold Forging Nut
Class
Cutting Processed Nut
4N
No Mark
5N (4T)
No Mark (w/ Washer)
No Mark (w/ Washer)
No Mark
6N
6N
7N (5T)
*
8N
8N
10N (7T)
10N
No Mark
11N
11N
12N
12N
*: Nut with 1 or more marks on one side surface of the nut.
B06432
HINT:
Use the nut with the same number of the nut strength classification or the greater than the bolt strength classification number when tightening parts with a bolt and nut.
Example: Bolt = 4T
Nut = 4N or more
SS–4
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE MECHANICAL
SS0AD–04
SERVICE DATA
Compression
pressure
at 250 rpm STD 1,736 kPa (17.7 kgf/cm2, 252 psi) or more
Minimum 1,393 kPa (14.2 kgf/cm2, 202 psi)
Difference of pressure between each cylinder
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi) or less
Valve clearance
Adjusting shim (for repair part)
at cold Intake
Exhaust
Shim No.00
Shim No.04
Shim No.08
Shim No.02
Shim No.16
Shim No.20
Shim No.24
Shim No.28
Shim No.32
Shim No.36
Shim No.40
Shim No.44
Shim No.48
Shim No.52
Shim No.56
Shim No.60
Shim No.64
Shim No.68
Shim No.72
Shim No.76
Shim No.80
0.19 – 0.29 mm (0.007 – 0.011 in.)
0.28 – 0.38 mm (0.011 – 0.015 in.)
2.000 mm (0.0787 in.)
2.040 mm (0.0803 in.)
2.080 mm (0.0819 in.)
2.120 mm (0.0835 in.)
2.160 mm (0.0850 in.)
2.200 mm (0.0866 in.)
2.240 mm (0.0882 in.)
2.280 mm (0.0898 in.)
2.320 mm (0.0913 in.)
2.360 mm (0.0929 in.)
2.400 mm (0.0945 in.)
2.440 mm (0.0961 in.)
2.480 mm (0.0976 in.)
2.520 mm (0.0992 in.)
2.560 mm (0.1008 in.)
2.600 mm (0.1024 in.)
2.640 mm (0.1039 in.)
2.680 mm (0.1055 in.)
2.720 mm (0.1071 in.)
2.760 mm (0.1087 in.)
2.800 mm (0.1102 in.)
Valve spring
Deviation
Free length
Installed tension at 35 mm (1.378 in.)
Camshaft
Cam lobe height
STD Intake
Exhaust
Minimum Intake
Exhaust
42.21 – 42.31 mm (1.6618 – 1.6657 in.)
40.62 – 40.72 mm (1.5992 – 1.6031 in.)
42.10 mm (1.6575 in.)
40.51 mm (1.5949 in.)
Piston and
piston ring
Piston diameter
STD Mark 1
Mark 2
Mark 3
O/S 0.50
STD
Maximum
No.1
No.2
STD No.1
No.2
Oil (side rail)
Maximum No.1
No.2
Oil (side rail)
86.815 – 86.825 mm (3.4179 – 3.4183 in.)
86.825 – 86.835 mm (3.4183 – 3.4186 in.)
86.835 – 86.845 mm (3.4201 – 3.4205 in.)
87.350 – 87.380 mm (3.4375 – 3.4387 in.)
0.175 – 0.195 mm (0.0068 – 0.0076 in.)
0.215 mm (0.0085 in.)
0.020 – 0.070 mm (0.0008 – 0.0003 in.)
0.020 – 0.055 mm (0.0008 – 0.0022 in.)
0.220 – 0.440 mm (0.0087 – 0.0173 in.)
0.600 – 0.820 mm (0.0177 – 0.0322 in.)
0.100 – 0.470 mm (0.0039 – 0.0185 in.)
1.04 mm (0.0409 in.)
1.42 mm (0.0559 in.)
1.07 mm (0.0421in.)
Piston oil clearance
Piston ring groove clearance
Piston ring end gap
Maximum 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
45.9 – 47.9 mm (1.8071 – 1.8858 in.)
169 – 184 N (17.2 – 18.8 kgf, 37.9 – 41.4 lbf)
Author:
Date:
62
SS–5
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SFI
SFI
SS0AG–04
SERVICE DATA
Fuel pressure
Fuel pressure
between fuel tank and pressure regulatorat 20°C (68°F)
between pressure regulator and injector
24,800 kPa (250 kgf/cm2, 3,600 psi)
834 – 932 kPa (8.5 – 9.5 kgf/cm2, 121 – 135 psi)
Injector
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
2.65 – 3.0 Ω
Fuel shutoff valve
for delivery pipe
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
1.8 – 2.2 Ω
Fuel shutoff valve
for fuel pressure
regulator
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
1.4 – 1.8 Ω
Fuel shutoff valve
for fuel tank
Resistance
at 20°C (68°F)
Approx 19 Ω
Fuel temperature
sensor for
delivery pipe
Resistance
at –20°C (–4°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
at 80°C (176°F)
13.9 – 16.3 kΩ
2.32 – 2.59 kΩ
0.31 – 0.326 kΩ
Fuel temperature
sensor for
fuel tank
Resistance
at –30°C (–22°F)
at 25°C (77°F)
at 40°C (104°F)
at 100°C (212°F)
80 – 100 kΩ
4.80 – 5.20 kΩ
2.51 – 2.81 kΩ
0.30 – 0.37 kΩ
Fuel pressure
sensor for
delivery pipe
Power source voltage
Power output voltage
at 20°C (68°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
4.5 – 5.5 V
3.1 – 3.6 V
Fuel pressure
sensor for
fuel pipe
Power source voltage
Power output voltage
Needle position of fuel level gauge
at 20°C (68°F)
at 20°C (68°F)
at 4/4
at 3/4
at 2/4
at 1/4
4.5 – 5.5 V
Fuel cut rpm
Fuel return rpm
A/C OFF
Approx. 2.8 V
Approx. 2.4 V
Approx. 1.8 V
Approx. 1.3 V
1,400 rpm
Author:
Date:
63
SS–6
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SFI
SS0AH–04
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
42
28
428
286
31
21
Fuel filter x Drain plug
10.8
110
8
Fuel filter x Fuel filter bracket
21.5
219
16
31
316
23
24.5
250
18
20
200
15
9.9
19.6
100
200
88 in.·lbf
14
Fuel relief pipe x Fuel pressure regulator
42
428
31
Delivery pipe x cylinder head
13
130
10
Fuel tank band x Fuel tank frame
52
530
38
Rear side plate x Front side plate
100
1,020
74
31
18
316
184
23
13
8.2
84
73 in.·lbf
Fuel line for union
for fuel inlet coupler
for others
Fuel filter x Union
Oil separator x Fuel pressure regulator
Fuel pressure regulator x Bracket
Fuel pressure regulator bracket x Body
Union x Fuel shutoff valve
Fuel tank bracket x Fuel tank valve case
for 10 mm head bolt
for 12 mm head bolt
for fuel pipe filter pipe
for others
Fuel tank valve cover x Fuel tank valve case
8.2
84
73 in.·lbf
Fuel tank frame x Body
60.2
614
44
Performance rod x Body
39.2
400
29
Performance rod x Fuel tank band
18.1
185
13
Fuel shutoff valve core x Delivery pipe
35
357
26
Fuel shutoff valve coil x Core
15
153
11
Fuel temperature sensor x Delivery pipe
20.4
208
15
Fuel pressure sensor x Delivery pipe
24.6
251
18
Fuel pressure sensor x Fuel main pipe
68.6
700
51
Fuel inlet hose x Fuel pressure regulator
9.9
100
88 in.·lbf
SS–7
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
IGNITION
IGNITION
SS0AM–04
SERVICE DATA
Spark plug
Recommended spark plug
DENSO made
Correct electrode gap for new spark plug
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug
SK20R11–G
1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
1.2 mm (0.047 in.)
Author:
Date:
65
SS–8
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
IGNITION
SS0AN–04
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
Spark plug x Cylinder head
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
18
180
13
SS–9
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SS04W–03
SERVICE DATA
Vehicle height
Tire size: 205/65R15
218 mm (8.58 in.)
Rear*6
270 mm (10.63 in.)
Ri h l f error
Right–left
–0°36’
0°36’ ± 45’ (0
(0.6°
6° ± 0.75°)
0 75°)
45’ (0
(0.75°)
75°) or lless
Right–left error
2°10’ ± 45’ (2.17° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Right–left error
13°01’ ± 45’ (13.02° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
Camber
Caster
Front wheel
alignment
Front*5
Steering axis inclination
Toe–in (Total)
0° ± 12’ (0° ± 0.2° 0 ± 2 mm 0 ± 0.08 in.)
Rack end length difference 1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
Wheel angle
Camber
Right–left error
Rear wheel
alignment
Toe–in (total)
35°50’ ± 2° (35.84° ± 2°)
Inside wheel
Outside wheel
31°28’ (31.47°)
–0°45’ ± 45’ (–0.75° ± 0.75°)
45’ (0.75°) or less
0°24’ ± 12’ (0.4° ± 0.2°)
4 ± 2 mm (0.16 ± 0.08 in.)
No. 2 lower suspension arm length difference 1 mm (0.04 in.) or less
*1: Front measuring point
Measure the distance from the ground to the center of the front side lower suspension arm mounting bolt.
*2: Rear measuring point
Measure the distance from the ground to the center of the front side strut rod mounting bolt.
F t axle
Front
l
Axle bearing backlash
Maximum 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Axle hub deviation
Maximum 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Drive shaft standard length
Front drive shaft
F t suspension
Front
i
R
Rear
axle
l
R
Rear
suspension
i
LH
RH
609.2 ± 2.0 mm (23.984 ± 0.079 in.)
842.9 ± 2.0 mm (33.185 ± 0.079 in.)
Lower ball joint turning torque
1.0 – 3.4 N·m (10 – 35 kgf·cm, 8.7 – 30 in.·lbf)
Stabilizer bar link turning torque
0.05 – 1.0 N·m (0.5 – 10 kgf·cm, 0.4 – 8.7 in.·lbf)
Axle bearing backlash
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Axle hub deviation
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
No. 2 lower suspension arm length
512.3 mm (20.169 in.)
Stabilizer bar link turning torque
0.05 – 1.0 N·m (0.5 – 10 kgf·cm, 0.4 – 8.7 in.·lbf)
Author:
Date:
67
SS–10
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
SUSPENSION AND AXLE
SS04X–03
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Hub nut
103
1,050
76
Steering knuckle x Shock absorber
211
2,150
156
Steering knuckle x Brake caliper
107
1,090
79
Steering knuckle x Tie rod end
49
500
36
Axle hub x Drive shaft
294
3,000
217
Lower ball joint x Lower suspension arm
127
1,300
94
Lower ball joint x Steering knuckle
123
1,250
90
ABS speed sensor set bolt
8.0
82
71 in.·lbf
Tie lod end lock nut
74
750
54
32
330
24
Suspension support x Body
80
820
59
Suspension support x Piston rod
49
500
36
Flexible hose and ABS speed sensor wire harness x Shock absorber
29
300
22
Lower suspension arm set bolt
206
2,100
152
Stabilizer bar link set bolt
39
400
29
Hub nut
103
1,050
76
Axle hub set bolt
80
820
59
Shock absorber x Rear axle carrier
New nut
Reused nut (Apply engine oil to the threads.)
255
196
2,600
2,000
188
145
No. 1, No. 2 lower suspension arm x Rear axle carrier
181
1,850
134
Strut rod x Rear axle carrier
113
1,150
83
Flexible hose x Shock absorber
29
300
22
ABS speed sensor set bolt
8.0
82
71 in.·lbf
ABS speed sensor wire harness x Shock absorber
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Rear seat outer belt lower side set bolt
42
430
31
Suspension support x Body
39
400
29
Suspension support x Piston rod
49
500
36
Parking brake cable set bolt
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
No. 2 lower suspension arm lock nut
56
570
41
No. 1, No. 2 lower suspension arm x Suspension member
181
1,850
134
Strut rod x Body
113
1,150
83
Stabilizer bar bracket x Suspension member
19
195
14
Stabilizer bar link set nut
39
400
29
FRONT AXLE
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Drive shaft center bearing lock bolt
FRONT SUSPENSION
REAR AXLE
REAR SUSPENSION
SS–11
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
BODY ELECTRICAL
BODY ELECTRICAL
SS0B0–06
SERVICE DATA
FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE
A–B
Approx. 270.1 Ω
A–C
Approx. 141.3 Ω
B–C
Approx. 128.8 Ω
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE (Resistance)
A–B
Approx. 175.7 Ω
A–C
Approx. 54.0 Ω
B–C
Approx. 229.7 Ω
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENDER GAUGE (Resistance)
Temperature °C (°F)
Resistance (Ω)
50 (122.0)
160 – 240
120 (248.0)
17.1 – 21.2
Author:
Date:
69
SS–12
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
–
BODY
SS13F–01
TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Part tightened
REAR BUMPER
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
–
–
–
Rear bumper cover x Body
4.9
51
43 in.·lbf
Rear bumper reinforcement x Body
34
350
25
Rear bumper side retainer x Body
4.9
51
43 in.·lbf
–
–
–
Door lock striker x Body
5.4
55
49 in.·lbf
Door lock x Door panel
5.4
55
49 in.·lbf
Luggage compartment door hinge x Door panel
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
–
–
–
18
185
13
SEAT BELT
–
–
–
Front seat belt
–
–
–
Upper:
7.8
80
69 in.·lbf
Lower:
41
420
30
Inner belt x Seat
41
420
30
Shoulder anchor x Body
41
420
30
Floor anchor x Body
41
420
30
Rear seat belt
–
–
–
Retractor x Body
41
420
30
Floor anchor x Body
41
420
30
RH center belt x Body
41
420
30
LH center belt x Body
41
420
30
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
REAR SEAT
Rear seatback x Body
Retractor x Body
Author:
Date:
70
EC–1
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EC039–05
PURPOSE
The emission control systems are installed to reduce the amount of HC, CO and NOx exhausted from the
engine ((3), (4) and (5)), to prevent the atmospheric release of blow–by gas–containing HC (1) and evaporated fuel containing HC being released from the fuel tank (2).
The function of each system is shown in the following table.
System
(1) Positive Crankcase Ventilation
(2) Evaporative Emission Control
(3) Exhaust Gas Recirculation
(4) Three–Way Catalytic Converter
(5) Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection*
Abbreviation
PCV
EVAP
EGR
TWC
SFI
Function
Reduces HC
Reduces evaporated HC
Reduces NOx
Reduces HC, CO and NOx
Injects a precisely timed, optimum amount of fuel for reduced
exhaust emissions
Remark: * For inspection and repair of the SFI system, refer to the SFI section in this manual.
Author:
Date:
1399
EC–2
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
PARTS LAYOUT AND SCHEMATIC DRAWING
PARTS LAYOUT AND SCHEMATIC DRAWING
EC03A–03
LOCATION
EGR Vacuum Modulator
EGR Valve
PCV Valve
TWC (Except California)
Rear TWC (California)
VSV for EGR
Front TWC
(California)
VSV for EVAP
EVAP Service Port
Vapor Pressure Sensor
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
Vent Line
Charcoal Canister
Cutoff Valve
Fuel Tank Cap
Fuel Tank
EVAP Line
Fill Check Valve
Air Drain Hose
Filler Pipe
Purge Line
Air Inlet Line
B06542
Author:
Date:
1400
EC–3
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
PARTS LAYOUT AND SCHEMATIC DRAWING
EC03B–03
DRAWING
EVAP Service Port
EGR Vacuum Modulator
VSV
for EVAP
EGR
Valve
Front TWC
(California)
VSV for EGR
TWC (Except California)
Rear TWC (California)
Purge Line
Fuel Tank Cap
EVAP Line
Filler Pipe
Vent Line
Fuel Tank
Charcoal Canister
Vapor
Pressure
Sensor
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
Air Inlet Line
Air Drain Hose
B06549
Author:
Date:
1401
EC–4
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV)
SYSTEM
POSITIVE CRANKCASE
VENTILATION (PCV) SYSTEM
EC03C–05
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT PCV VALVE
Remove the PCV valve.
(b)
(c)
Install a clean hose to the PCV valve.
Inspect the PCV valve operation.
(1) Blow air into the cylinder head side, and check that
air passes through easily.
CAUTION:
Do not suck air through the valve. Petroleum substances
inside the valve are harmful.
Clean Hose
Cylinder Head Side
B01531
Intake
Manifold
Side
Clean Hose
(2)
Blow air into the intake manifold side, and check
that air passes through with difficulty.
If operation is not as specified, replace the PCV valve.
(d) Remove the clean hose from the PCV valve.
(e) Reinstall the PCV valve.
B01532
2.
INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND GASKETS
Visually check for cracks, leaks or damage.
S01846
Author:
Date:
1402
EC–5
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
EC03D–05
COMPONENTS
Charcoal Canister
VSV for Vapor Pressure Sensor
Connector
EVAP Line Hose
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Mounting Bolt
Vent Line Hose
Air Inlet Line Hose
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Connector
Purge Line Hose
Air Drain Hose
Charcoal Canister
Assembly
39.2 (400, 29)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
B06534
Author:
Date:
1403
EC–6
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
EC03E–05
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT LINES AND CONNECTORS
Visually check for loose connections, sharp bends or damage.
2.
INSPECT FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE
Visually check for deformation, cracks or fuel leakage.
3.
INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP
Visually check if the cap and/or gasket are deformed or damaged.
If necessary, repair or replace the cap.
Type A
Gasket
Type B
Gasket
B01082
B04812
B06707
4.
(a)
Vacuum
Gauge
(b)
INSPECT EVAP SYSTEM LINE
Warm up the engine and stop the engine.
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
Install a vacuum gauge (EVAP control system test equipment vacuum gauge) to the EVAP service port on the
purge line.
B06544
(c)
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester:
Forced driving of the VSV for the EVAP.
(1) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Start the engine.
(3) Push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
(4) Use the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester to operate the VSV for the EVAP.
S05331
Author:
Date:
1404
EC–7
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
Battery
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
If you have no TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester:
Forced driving of the VSV for the EVAP.
(1) Disconnect the VSV connector for the EVAP.
(2) Connect the positive (+) and negative (–) leads from
the battery to the VSV terminals for the EVAP.
(3) Start the engine.
(e)
Check the vacuum at idle.
Vacuum:
Maintain at 0.368 – 19.713 in.Hg (5 – 268 in.Aq) for over
5 seconds
B06548
B06545
HINT:
If the vacuum does not change, you can conclude that the hose
connecting the VSV to the service port has come loose or is
blocked, or the VSV is malfunctioning.
(f)
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester:
Conclude forced driving of the VSV for the EVAP.
(1) Stop the engine.
(2) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
(g) If you have no TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester:
Conclude forced driving of the VSV for the EVAP.
(1) Stop the engine.
(2) Disconnect the positive (+) and negative (–) leads
from the battery from the VSV terminals for the
EVAP.
(3) Connect the VSV connector for the EVAP.
(h) Disconnect the vacuum gauge from the EVAP service
port on the purge line.
(i)
Connect a pressure gauge to the EVAP service port on
the purge line.
(j)
Hose Clipper
Check the pressure.
(1) Close off the air drain hose at the marked position
of the canister with a hose clipper or similar instrument.
Air Drain Hose
B06543
Author:
Date:
1405
EC–8
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
(2)
Add the pressure (13.5 – 15.5 in.Aq) from the EVAP
service port.
Pressure:
2 minutes after the pressure is added, the gauge
should be over 7.7 – 8.8 in.Aq.
Pressure
Gauge
Pressure
B06546
HINT:
If you can’t add pressure, you can conclude that the hose connecting the VSVcanisterfuel tank has slipped off or the
VSV is open.
(3)
Fuel Tank Cap
Check if the pressure decreases when the fuel tank
cap is removed while adding pressure.
HINT:
If the pressure does not decrease when the filler cap is removed, then you can conclude that the hose connecting the
service port to the fuel tank is blocked, etc.
(k) Disconnect the pressure gauge from the EVAP service
port on the purge line.
B06547
EVAP Line Hose
Air
Disconnect
B01250
EVAP Line Hose
5.
CHECK AIRTIGHTNESS IN FUEL TANK AND FILLER
PIPE
(a) Disconnect the EVAP line hose from the charcoal canister
side and then pressurize and make the internal pressure
in the fuel tank 4 kPa (41 gf/cm2, 0.58 psi).
(b) Check that the internal pressure of the fuel tank can be
hold for 1 minute.
(c) Check the connected portions of each hose and pipe.
(d) Check the installed parts on the fuel tank.
If there is no abnormality, replace the fuel tank and filler pipe.
(e) Reconnect the EVAP line hose to the charcoal canister.
6.
(a)
Disconnect
Disconnect
Cap
Purge Line Hose
Purge Port
Air
(b)
(c)
INSPECT FUEL CUTOFF VALVE AND FILL CHECK
VALVE
Disconnect the purge line hose and EVAP line hose from
the charcoal canister.
Plug the cap to the air drain hose.
Pressurize 4 kPa (41 gf/cm2, 0.58 psi) to the purge port
and check that there is ventilation through the EVAP line
hose.
B01251
Author:
Date:
1406
EC–9
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
Air Inlet Line Hose
Disconnect
Air
B01252
Push
Pinch
A
A
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
In the condition that the fuel fuel is full, as the float value of the
fill check valve is closed and has no ventilation, it is necessary
to check the fuel amount (volume).
(d) Check if there is any struck in the vent line hose and EVAP
line hose.
If there is no stuck in hoses, replace the fuel cutoff valve and fill
check valve.
(e) Reconnect the purge line hose and EVAP line hose to the
charcoal canister.
7.
CHECK AIR INLET LINE
(a) Disconnect the air inlet line hose from the charcoal canister.
(b) Check that there is ventilation in the air inlet line.
(c) Reconnect the air inlet line hose to the charcoal canister.
8.
REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the VSV connector.
(b) Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
(c) Disconnect the purge line hose, EVAP line hose and air
inlet line hose from the charcoal canister.
(d) Disconnect the vent line hose from the charcoal canister.
(1) Push the connector deep inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(e) Remove the 2 charcoal canister mounting bolts.
(f)
Remove the vapor pressure sensor mounting bolt.
(g) Remove the charcoal canister assembly.
Pinch
B01253
9.
(a)
INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER
Visually check the charcoal canister for cracks or damage.
(b)
Inspect the charcoal canister operation.
(1) Plug the vent port with a cap.
(2) While holding the purge port closed, blow air (1.76
kPa, 18 gf/cm2, 0.26 psi) into the EVAP port and
check that air flows from the air drain port.
B01148
Purge Port
Vent Port
Cap
Air
Air Drain Port
E VA P
Port
B01149
Author:
Date:
1407
EC–10
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
Purge Port
Air Inlet Port
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
(3)
While holding the purge port and the air drain port
closed, blow air (1.76 kPa, 18 gf/cm2, 0.26 psi) into
the EVAP port and check that air does not flow from
the air inlet port.
(4)
Apply vacuum (3.43 kPa, 25.7 mmHg, 1.01 in.Hg)
to the purge port, check that the vacuum does not
decrease when the air inlet port is closed, and
check that the vacuum decreases when the air inlet
port is released.
Air Drain Port
Air
–
EVAP
Port
B01150
Air Inlet Port
Vacuum
Air Inlet Port
Purge Port
B01151
Purge Port
EVAP
Port
Vacuum
B01152
(5)
While holding the air inlet port closed, apply vacuum
(3.43 kPa, 25.7 mmHg, 1.01 in.Hg) to the EVAP port
and check that air flows into the purge port.
If operation is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister.
(6) Remove the cap from the vent port.
10. INSPECT VSV FOR EVAP (See page SF–45)
11. INSPECT VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(See page SF–47)
12. INSPECT VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(See page SF–55)
13. REINSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
Author:
Date:
1408
EC–11
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
EC03F–03
COMPONENTS
EGR Valve
Vacuum Hose
Vacuum Hose
EGR Valve
Gasket
Gasket
Non–reusable part
S05556
Author:
Date:
1409
EC–12
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
EC03G–04
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
Cap
Filter
S05568
HINT:
Install the filter with the coarser surface facing the atmospheric
side (outward).
(b)
Vacuum Gauge
INSPECT EGR SYSTEM
Inspect and clean the filter in the EGR vacuum modulator.
(1) Remove the cap and filter.
(2) Check the filter for contamination or damage.
(3) Using compressed air, clean the filter.
(4) Reinstall the filter and cap.
(c)
Using a 3–way connector, connect a vacuum gauge to the
hose between the EGR valve and VSV.
Inspect seating of the EGR valve.
Start the engine and check that the engine starts and runs
at idle.
3–Way Connector
B06540
TE1
(d)
E1
(e)
SST
Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
Inspect the VSV operation with the cold engine.
(1) The engine coolant temperature should be below
55°C (131°F).
(2) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates zero at
2,500 rpm.
A07370
HOT
High Vacuum at 2,500 rpm
Port R
Disconnect
B06541
(f)
Inspect the operation of the VSV and EGR vacuum modulator with the hot engine.
(1) Warm up the engine to above 60°C (140°F).
(2) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates low vacuum at 2,500 rpm.
(3) Disconnect the vacuum hose port R of the EGR vacuum modulator and connect port R directly to the intake manifold with another hose.
(4) Check that the vacuum gauge indicates high vacuum at 2,500 rpm.
Author:
Date:
1410
EC–13
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
HINT:
As a large amount of exhaust gas enters, the engine will misfire
slightly.
(g) Remove the vacuum gauge, and reconnect the vacuum
hoses to the proper locations.
(h)
Disconnect
B06539
HINT:
As exhaust gas is increasingly recirculated, the engine will start
to misfire.
(i)
Remove the SST from the DLC1.
SST 09843–18020
2.
(a)
Engine Stopped
Inspect the EGR valve.
(1) Apply vacuum directly to the EGR valve with the engine idling.
(2) Check that the engine runs rough or dies.
(3) Reconnect the vacuum hoses to the proper locations.
Air
(b)
(c)
INSPECT EGR VACUUM MODULATOR
Disconnect the vacuum hoses from ports P, Q and R of
the EGR vacuum modulator.
Block ports P and R with your finger.
Blow air into port Q, and check that the air passes through
to the air filter side freely.
S05567
(d)
(e)
Engine at
2,500 rpm
Air
(f)
Start the engine, and maintain speed at 2,500 rpm.
Repeat the above test. Check that there is a strong resistance to air flow.
Reconnect the vacuum hoses to the proper locations.
S05566
Author:
Date:
1411
EC–14
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
3.
(a)
(b)
S05559
If a
(c)
4.
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
INSPECT EGR VALVE
Remove the EGR valve.
(1) Disconnect the 2 vacuum hoses from the EGR
valve.
(2) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts, EGR valve and 2 gaskets.
Check the EGR valve for sticking and heavy carbon deposits.
problem is found, replace the valve.
Reinstall the EGR valve.
(1) Temporarily 2 new gasket and the EGR valve with
the 2 nuts and 2 bolts.
(2) Tighten the nuts.
Torque: 13.3 N·m (136 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
(3) Tighten the bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (102 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(4) Connect the 2 vacuum hoses to the EGR valve.
INSPECT VSV FOR EGR (See page SF–43)
Author:
Date:
1412
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC)
SYSTEM
EC–15
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC) SYSTEM
EC03H–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the connections for looseness or damage.
(b) Check the clamps for weakness, cracks or damage.
2.
INSPECT REAR TWC
Check for dents or damage.
If any part of the protector is damaged or dented to the extent that it contacts the TWC, repair or replace
it.
3.
INSPECT REAR TWC HEAT INSULATOR
(a) Check the heat insulator for damage.
(b) Check for adequate clearance between the catalytic converter and heat insulator.
Author:
Date:
1413
EC–16
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC)
SYSTEM
EC03I–04
COMPONENTS
Front TWC (California)
A/F Sensor Connector
Gasket
No.1 Exhaust Manifold
Heat Insulator
49 (500, 36)
Exhaust Manifold
(Front TWC)
x6
No.3 Exhaust
Manifold Heat
Insulator
No.2 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
(TMMK Made)
(TMC Made)
No.1 Exhaust
Manifold Stay
A/F Sensor
44 (450, 32)
Clamp
62 (630,46)
Gasket
No.2 Exhaust Manifold
Heat Insulator
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06537
Author:
Date:
1414
EMISSION CONTROL (5S–FE)
–
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC)
SYSTEM
EC–17
TWC (Except California)
Rear TWC (California)
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Gasket
TWC (Except California)
Rear TWC (California)
62 (630, 46)
Front Exhaust Pipe
Stay
Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06538
Author:
Date:
1415
EC–1
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EC01U–03
PURPOSE
The emission control systems are installed to reduce the amount of CO, HC and NOx exhausted from the
engine ((3), (4), (5) and (6)), to prevent the atmospheric release of blow–by gas–containing HC (1) and evaporated fuel containing HC being released from the fuel tank (2).
The function of each system is shown in these table.
System
(1) Positive Crankcase Ventilation
(2) Evaporative Emission Control
(3) Exhaust Gas Recirculation
(4) Warm Up Three–Way Catalytic Converter
(5) Three–Way Catalytic Converter
(6) Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection*
Abbreviation
PCV
EVAP
EGR
WU–TWC
TWC
SFI
Function
Reduces HC
Reduces evaporated HC
Reduces NOx
Reduces HC, CO and NOx
Reduces HC, CO and NOx
Injects a precisely timed, optimum amount of fuel for reduced
exhaust emissions
Remark: * For inspection and repair of the SFI system, refer to the SF section of this manual.
Author:
Date:
1416
EC–2
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
PARTS LAYOUT AND SCHEMATIC DRAWING
PARTS LAYOUT AND SCHEMATIC DRAWING
EC01V–03
LOCATION
Vacuum Surge Tank
EGR Valve
VSV for EGR
VSV for EVAP
Vacuum Surge Tank
EVAP Service Port
VCV
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Charcoal Canister
VSV for Vapor Pressure Sensor
Vent Line
EVAP Line
Fuel Tank
Fill Check Valve
Fuel Tank Cap
Air Drain Hose
Filler Pipe
Purge Line
Cut Off Valve
Air Inlet Line
B06386
Author:
Date:
1417
EC–3
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
PARTS LAYOUT AND SCHEMATIC DRAWING
EC01W–03
DRAWING
VSV for EGR
VCV
EVAP Service Port
Vacuum Surge
Tank
Purge Line
VSV for EVAP
EVAP Line
EGR Valve
Position
Sensor
Vent Line
Vapor Pressure
Sensor
Fuel Tank
Charcoal
Canister
Air Inlet Line
VSV for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
Air Drain Hose
A/F Sensor
(California A/T)
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1/
Except California A/T)
A/F Sensor
(California A/T)
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 2 Sensor 1/
Except California A/T)
WU–TWC
(California A/T)
WU–TWC
(California A/T)
TWC
Heated Oxygen
Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
B06721
Author:
Date:
1418
EC–4
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV)
SYSTEM
POSITIVE CRANKCASE
VENTILATION (PCV) SYSTEM
EC01X–03
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT PCV VALVE
Remove the PCV valve.
(b)
(c)
Install clean hose to the PCV valve.
Inspect the PCV valve operation.
(1) Blow air into the cylinder head side, and check that
air passes through easily.
CAUTION:
Do not suck air through the valve.
Petroleum substances inside the valve are harmful.
Clean Hose
Cylinder Head side
P02006
(2)
Air Intake
Chamber Side
Blow air into the air intake chamber side, and check
that air passes through with difficulty.
If operation is not as specified, replace the PCV valve.
(d) Remove clean hose from the PCV valve.
(e) Reinstall the PCV valve.
P02477
2.
INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND GASKETS
Visually check for cracks, leaks or damage.
P12931
Author:
Date:
1419
EC–5
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
EC0AU–01
COMPONENTS
VSV Connector for Vapor
Pressure Sensor
EVAP Line Hose
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Vent Line Hose
Air Inlet Line Hose
Vapor Pressure Sensor
Connector
Purge Line Hose
Air Drain Hose
VSV for Vapor Pressure Sensor
Charcoal Canister
39.2 (400, 29)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
B01507
Author:
Date:
1420
EC–6
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
EC0AV–01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT LINES AND CONNECTORS
Visually check for loose connections, sharp bends or damage.
2.
INSPECT FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE
Visually check for deformation, cracks or fuel leakage.
3.
INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP
Visually check if the cap and/or gasket are deformed or damaged.
If necessary, repair or replace the cap.
Type A
Gasket
Type B
Gasket
B01082
B04812
B06707
4.
(a)
Vacuum
Gauge
(b)
INSPECT EVAP SYSTEM LINE
Warm up the engine and stop the engine.
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
Install a vacuum gauge (EVAP control system test equipment vacuum gauge) to the EVAP service port on the
purge line.
B06544
TOYOTA
Hand–Held Tester
DLC3
(c)
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester:
Forced driving of the VSV for the EVAP.
(1) Connect a TOYOTA hand–held tester to the DLC3.
(2) Start the engine.
(3) Push the TOYOTA hand–held tester main switch
ON.
(4) Use the ACTIVE TEST mode on the TOYOTA
hand–held tester to operate the VSV for the EVAP.
S05331
Author:
Date:
1421
EC–7
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
If you have no TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester:
Forced driving of the VSV for the EVAP.
(1) Disconnect the VSV connector for the EVAP.
(2) Connect the positive (+) and negative (–) leads from
the battery to the VSV terminals for the EVAP.
(3) Start the engine.
(e)
Check the vacuum at idle.
Vacuum:
Maintain at 0.368 – 19.713 in.Hg (5 – 268 in.Aq) for over
5 seconds
Battery
B06722
B06545
HINT:
If the vacuum does not change, you can conclude that the hose
connecting the VSV to the service port has come loose or is
blocked, or the VSV is malfunctioning.
(f)
TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester:
Conclude forced driving of the VSV for the EVAP.
(1) Stop the engine.
(2) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand–held tester from the
DLC3.
(g) If you have no TOYOTA Hand–Held Tester:
Conclude forced driving of the VSV for the EVAP.
(1) Stop the engine.
(2) Disconnect the positive (+) and negative (–) leads
from the battery from the VSV terminals for the
EVAP.
(3) Connect the VSV connector for the EVAP.
(h) Disconnect the vacuum gauge from the EVAP service
port on the purge line.
(i)
Connect a pressure gauge to the EVAP service port on
the purge line.
(j)
Hose Clipper
Check the pressure.
(1) Close off the air drain hose at the marked position
of the canister with a hose clipper or similar instrument.
Air Drain Hose
B06543
Author:
Date:
1422
EC–8
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
(2)
Add the pressure (13.5 – 15.5 in.Aq) from the EVAP
service port.
Pressure:
2 minutes after the pressure is added, the gauge
should be over 7.7 – 8.8 in.Aq.
Pressure
Gauge
Pressure
B06546
HINT:
If you can’t add pressure, you can conclude that the hose connecting the VSVcanisterfuel tank has slipped off or the
VSV is open.
(3)
Fuel Tank Cap
Check if the pressure decreases when the fuel tank
cap is removed while adding pressure.
HINT:
If the pressure does not decrease when the filler cap is removed, then you can conclude that the hose connecting the
service port to the fuel tank is blocked, etc.
(k) Disconnect the pressure gauge from the EVAP service
port on the purge line.
B06547
EVAP Line Hose
Air
Disconnect
B01250
EVAP Line Hose
5.
CHECK AIRTIGHTNESS IN FUEL TANK AND FILLER
PIPE
(a) Disconnect the EVAP line hose from the charcoal canister
side and then pressurize and make the internal pressure
in the fuel tank 4 kPa (41 gf/cm2, 0.58 psi).
(b) Check that the internal pressure of the fuel tank can be
hold for 1 minute.
(c) Check the connected portions of each hose and pipe.
(d) Check the installed parts on the fuel tank.
If there is no abnormality, replace the fuel tank and filler pipe.
(e) Reconnect the EVAP line hose to the charcoal canister.
6.
(a)
Disconnect
Disconnect
Cap
Purge Line Hose
Purge Port
Air
(b)
(c)
INSPECT FUEL CUTOFF VALVE AND FILL CHECK
VALVE
Disconnect the purge line hose and EVAP line hose from
the charcoal canister.
Plug the cap to the air drain hose.
Pressurize 4 kPa (41 gf/cm2, 0.58 psi) to the purge port
and check that there is ventilation through the EVAP line
hose.
B01251
Author:
Date:
1423
EC–9
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
Air Inlet Line Hose
Disconnect
Air
B01252
Push
Pinch
A
A
–
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
In the condition that the fuel fuel is full, as the float value of the
fill check valve is closed and has no ventilation, it is necessary
to check the fuel amount (volume).
(d) Check if there is any struck in the vent line hose and EVAP
line hose.
If there is no stuck in hoses, replace the fuel cutoff valve and fill
check valve.
(e) Reconnect the purge line hose and EVAP line hose to the
charcoal canister.
7.
CHECK AIR INLET LINE
(a) Disconnect the air inlet line hose from the charcoal canister.
(b) Check that there is ventilation in the air inlet line.
(c) Reconnect the air inlet line hose to the charcoal canister.
8.
REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the VSV connector.
(b) Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
(c) Disconnect the purge line hose, EVAP line hose and air
inlet line hose from the charcoal canister.
(d) Disconnect the vent line hose from the charcoal canister.
(1) Push the connector deep inside.
(2) Pinch portion A.
(3) Pull out the connector.
(e) Remove the 2 charcoal canister mounting bolts.
(f)
Remove the vapor pressure sensor mounting bolt.
(g) Remove the charcoal canister assembly.
Pinch
B01253
9.
(a)
INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER
Visually check the charcoal canister for cracks or damage.
(b)
Inspect the charcoal canister operation.
(1) Plug the vent port with a cap.
(2) While holding the purge port closed, blow air (1.76
kPa, 18 gf/cm2, 0.26 psi) into the EVAP port and
check that air flows from the air drain port.
B01148
Purge Port
Vent Port
Cap
Air
Air Drain Port
E VA P
Port
B01149
Author:
Date:
1424
EC–10
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
Purge Port
Air Inlet Port
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL SYSTEM
(3)
While holding the purge port and the air drain port
closed, blow air (1.76 kPa, 18 gf/cm2, 0.26 psi) into
the EVAP port and check that air does not flow from
the air inlet port.
(4)
Apply vacuum (3.43 kPa, 25.7 mmHg, 1.01 in.Hg)
to the purge port, check that the vacuum does not
decrease when the air inlet port is closed, and
check that the vacuum decreases when the air inlet
port is released.
Air Drain Port
Air
–
EVAP
Port
B01150
Air Inlet Port
Vacuum
Air Inlet Port
Purge Port
B01151
Purge Port
EVAP
Port
Vacuum
B01152
(5)
While holding the air inlet port closed, apply vacuum
(3.43 kPa, 25.7 mmHg, 1.01 in.Hg) to the EVAP port
and check that air flows into the purge port.
If operation is not as specified, replace the charcoal canister.
(6) Remove the cap from the vent port.
10. INSPECT VSV FOR EVAP (See page SF–58)
11. INSPECT VSV FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(See page SF–62)
12. INSPECT VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(See page SF–65)
13. REINSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER ASSEMBLY
Author:
Date:
1425
EC–11
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION
(EGR) SYSTEM
EC0AW–01
INSPECTION
1.
2.
(a)
Ohmmeter
Disconnect
E2 VC
S05477
VC(+)
INSPECT EGR SYSTEM (See page DI–358)
INSPECT EGR VALVE POSITION SENSOR
Inspect the resistance of the EGR valve position sensor.
(1) Disconnect the EGR valve position sensor connector.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals VC and E2.
Resistance: 1.5 – 4.3 kΩ
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the EGR valve position sensor.
(3) Reconnect the EGR valve position sensor connector.
(b)
E2(–)
Inspect the power output voltage of the EGR valve position sensor.
(1) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EGR valve.
(2) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(3) Connect a voltmeter to terminals VC and E2 of the
ECM, and measure the power source voltage.
Voltage: 4.5 – 5.5 V
B01480
Author:
Date:
1426
EC–12
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
(4)
Connect a voltmeter to terminals EGLS and E2 of
the ECM, and measure the power outlet voltage under the following conditions:
Using a MITYVAC (Hand–Held Vacuum
Pump), apply a vacuum (17.3 kPa, 130
mmHg, 5.1 in.Hg) to the EGR valve.
Voltage: 3.2 – 5.1 V
Release the vacuum from the EGR valve.
Voltage: 0.4 – 1.6 V
If the voltage is not as specified, replace the EGR valve position
sensor.
(5) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the EGR valve.
3.
REMOVE EGR POSITION SENSOR
Remove the 3 nuts and EGR valve position sensor from the
EGR valve.
Torque: 2 N·m (20 kgf·cm, 17 in.·lbf)
4.
REINSTALL EGR POSITION SENSOR
Installation is the reverse order of removal.
Disconnect
EGLS(+)
E2(–)
B01482
5.
(a)
S05452
(2)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install 2 new gaskets.
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(b) Disconnect the EGR gas temperature sensor connector
and clamp.
(c)
(1)
(3)
S05455
REMOVE EGR VALVE
Remove the EGR pipe.
Remove the 4 nuts, EGR pipe and 2 gaskets.
Remove the EGR valve.
(1) Disconnect the EVAP hose from the EGR valve
hook.
(2) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EGR valve.
(3) Disconnect the EGR valve position sensor connector.
Remove the 3 nuts, EGR valve and gasket.
(d)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install a new gasket.
Torque: 12 N·m (120 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(e) Remove the EGR gas temperature sensor.
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1427
EC–13
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM
6.
INSPECT EGR VALVE
Check for sticking and heavy carbon deposits.
If a problem is found, replace the EGR valve.
7.
REINSTALL EGR VALVE
Installation is the reverse order of removal.
8.
REMOVE VCV
S05454
9.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT VCV
Connect the MITYVAC (Hand–Held Vacuum Pump) to
port S of the VCV.
Plug port Z completely with fingers.
Z Port
S Port
S05478
(c)
Vacuum
(kPa, mmHg, in.Hg)
Pumping
(3 Times)
10 sec.
Time
S05476
Perform pumping 3 times and apply vacuum as shown in
the illustration.
(d) Stop the performing pumping and check the indicated value of the MITYVAC after about 10 seconds.
Standard value:
15 – 24 kPa (112 – 180 mmHg, 4.4 – 7.1 in.Hg)
If the indicated value is not as specified, replace the VCV.
10. REINSTALL VCV
11. INSPECT VSV FOR EGR (See page SF–56)
Author:
Date:
1428
EC–14
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
WARM UP THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
(WU–TWC) SYSTEM (California A/T)
WARM UP THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
(WU–TWC) SYSTEM (California A/T)
EC020–04
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the connections for looseness or damage.
(b) Check the clamps for weakness, cracks or damage.
2.
INSPECT WU–TWC
Check for dents or damage.
If any part of the protector is damaged or dented to the extent that it contacts the WU–TWC, repair or replace
it.
3.
INSPECT WU–TWC HEAT INSULATOR
(a) Check the heat insulator for damage.
(b) Check for adequate clearance between the catalytic converter and heat insulator.
Author:
Date:
1429
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
WARM UP THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
(WU–TWC) SYSTEM (California A/T)
EC–15
EC021–04
COMPONENTS
WU–TWC for Bank 1
56 (570, 41)
Bracket
21 (210, 15)
Gasket
Gasket
WU–TWC
62 (630, 46)
Front Exhaust Pipe
(Type A)
33 (330, 24)
Stay
62 (630, 46)
33 (330, 24)
Type B
WU–TWC
Front Exhaust Pipe
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06395
Author:
Date:
1430
EC–16
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
WARM UP THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
(WU–TWC) SYSTEM (California A/T)
WU–TWC for Bank 2
A/F Sensor Connector
Gasket
LH Exhaust Manifold
(with WU–TWC)
49 (500, 63)
x6
LH Exhaust Manifold
Heat Insulator
Gasket
A/F Sensor
44 (450, 32)
LH Exhaust Manifold Stay
62 (630, 46)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06478
Author:
Date:
1431
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC)
SYSTEM
EC–17
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC) SYSTEM
EC022–04
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the connections for looseness or damage.
(b) Check the clamps for weakness, cracks or damage.
2.
INSPECT TWC
Check for dents or damage.
If any part of the protector is damaged or dented to the extent that it contacts the TWC, repair or replace
it.
3.
INSPECT TWC HEAT INSULATOR
(a) Check the heat insulator for damage.
(b) Check for adequate clearance between the catalytic converter and heat insulator.
Author:
Date:
1432
EC–18
EMISSION CONTROL (1MZ–FE)
–
THREE–WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (TWC)
SYSTEM
EC023–04
COMPONENTS
56 (570, 41)
Bracket
21 (210, 15)
Gasket
Gasket
Gasket
TWC
62 (630, 46)
Bracket
Front Exhaust Pipe
(California A/T Type A)
Stay
33 (330, 24)
33 (330, 24)
62 (630, 46)
California A/T (Type B)
TWC
Front Exhaust Pipe
M/T
Except M/T and california A/T
TWC
TWC
Front Exhaust Pipe
Front Exhaust Pipe
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06396
Author:
Date:
1433
BE–1
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
BE09Y–01
PRECAUTION
Take care to observe the following precautions when performing inspections or removal and replacement
of body electrical related parts.
1.
HEADLIGHT SYSTEM
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and require special handling. They can burst if scratched
or dropped. Hold a bulb only by its plastic or metal case. Don’t touch the glass part of a bulb with bare
hands.
2.
SRS (SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM)
The CAMRY is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the driver airbag and
front passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service operation in the correct sequence could cause the
SRS to unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident. Before servicing
(including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the precautionary notices in the RS section.
3.
AUDIO SYSTEM
If the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the preset AM, FM 1 and FM 2 stations stored in memory are erased, so make sure to note the stations and reset them after the negative
(–) terminal cable is reconnected to the battery.
If the negative (–) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the ”ANTI–THEFT SYSTEM” will
operate when the cable is reconnected, but the radio, tape player and CD player will not operate. Be
sure to input the correct ID number so that the radio, tape player and CD player can be operated again.
4.
MOBILE COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to precautions in the IN section.
Author:
Date:
2221
BE–2
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
BE09Z–03
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
POWER OUTLET
Symptom
Electric power source cannot be taken out of the power outlet
Suspect Area
See page
11.Battery
12.POWER OUTLET Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
13.Wire Harness
–
–
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM (USA)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight is normal)
1. HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
2. Headlight Bulb
3. Wire Harness
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight does not light up)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Only one side light does not light.
1. HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
2. Headlight Bulb
3. Wire Harness
”Lo–Beam” does not light.
1. Headlight Bulb
2. Light Control Switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–24
–
”Hi–Beam” does not light.
1. Headlight Dimmer Switch
2. Light Control Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–24
BE–24
–
”Flash” does not light.
1. Headlight Dimmer Switch
2. Wire Harness
BE–24
–
”Auto Turn–off System” does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
–
–
BE–14
BE–24
BE–14
–
Taillight does not light. (Headlight does not light)
1. Light Control Switch
2. Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
BE–24
BE–14
–
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight is normal)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
–
BE–24
BE–24
BE–14
–
Only one side light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
Rear Combination light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Light Failure Sensor
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–37
–
”Auto Turn–off System” does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
–
BE–14
BE–32
–
HEAD–(LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Headlight Control Relay (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Headlight Bulb
Wire Harness
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.2)
Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
Ignition Switch
Wire Harness
TAIL Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Taillight Control Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Light Control Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
–
–
–
–
BE–24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
Wire Harness
Author:
Date:
2222
BE–3
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM (CANADA)
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight is normal)
1. Wire Harness
–
Headlight does not light.
(Taillight does not light up)
1. Wire Harness
–
Only one side light does not light.
1. Headlight Bulb
2. HEAD LO (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room R/B No.2)
3. Wire Harness
–
–
–
”Lo–Beam” does not light.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Headlight Bulb
HEAD LO (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room R/B No.2)
Headlight Control Relay (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Light Control Switch
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–24
BE–14
BE–24
–
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Headlight Bulb
ECU–B Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
DRL Fuse (E/G Room R/B No.2)
Daytime Running Light Relay No.2
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
6. Daytime Running Light Relay No.3
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
7. Daytime Running Light Relay No.4
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
8. Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
9. Headlight Dimmer Switch
10.Wire Harness
–
–
–
–
–
BE–24
–
BE–24
–
BE–24
BE–24
BE–24
–
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
”Flash” does not light.
Headlight Bulb
ECU–B Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
DRL Fuse (E/G Room R/B No.2)
Daytime Running Light Relay No.2
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
6. Daytime Running Light Relay No.3
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
7. Daytime Running Light Relay No.4
(E/G Room R/B No.2)
8. Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
9. Headlight Dimmer Switch
10.Wire Harness
–
–
–
–
–
BE–24
–
BE–24
–
BE–24
BE–24
BE–24
–
”Auto Turn–off System” does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.2)
Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
Ignition Switch
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–14
BE–24
BE–14
–
Headlight does not light with engine running and light control SW
OFF.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Headlight Bulb
ECU–B Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
HEAD HI (LH, RH) Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Daytime Running Light Relay (Main)
Wire Harness
Other Parts*
–
–
–
–
BE–24
–
–
”Hi–Beam” does not light.
Author:
Date:
2223
BE–4
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight does not light)
1. Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Light Control Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–14
BE–24
–
Taillight does not light.
(Headlight is normal)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
–
BE–24
BE–14
BE–24
–
Only one side light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
Rear Combination light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Light Failure Sensor
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–37
–
”Auto Turn–off System” does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
–
BE–14
BE–24
–
TAIL Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Taillight Control Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Light Control Switch
Wire Harness
–
–
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Door Courtesy Switch (Driver’s)
Wire Harness
*Terminal L of generator and parking brake switch
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
”Hazard” and ”Turn” do not light up.
1. Hazard Warning Switch
2. Turn Signal Flasher
3. Wire Harness
BE–30
BE–30
–
The flashing frequency is abnormal.
1. Bulb
2. Turn Signal Switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–30
–
Hazard warning light does not light up.
(Turn is normal.)
1. HORN Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
2. Wire Harness
Hazard warning light does not light up in one direction.
1. Hazard Warning Switch
2. Wire Harness
BE–30
–
*1Turn signal does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Ignition Switch
TURN Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Turn Signal Switch
Wire Harness
BE–14
–
BE–30
–
*2Turn signal does not light up.
1. TURN Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Turn Signal Switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–30
–
Turn signal does not light up in one direction.
1. Turn Signal Switch
2. Wire Harness
BE–30
–
Only one bulb does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
–
–
*1: Combination meter, wiper and washer do not operate.
*2: Combination meter, wiper and washer are normal.
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
”Illuminated Entry System” does not operate.
1. Door Courtesy Switch
2. Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
Only one interior light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Interior light does not light up (All).
1. DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Author:
BE–32
BE–14
–
Date:
2224
BE–5
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Dome light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Dome Light
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–32
–
Map Light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Map Light
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–32
–
Luggage compartment light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Luggage compartment door courtesy switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–32
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
Symptom
Back–Up Light does not light up.
Back–Up Light remains always ON.
Only one light does not light up.
Suspect Area
1.
2.
3.
4.
See page
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Ignition Switch
Wire Harness
Bulb
1. Back–Up Light Switch (M/T)
2. Park/Neutral Position Switch (A/T)
–
BE–14
–
–
3. Wire Harness
BE–35
DI–424
DI–479
–
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
(A140E)
(A541E)
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Stop light does not light up.
1. STOP Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Stop Light Switch
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–37
–
Only one light always lights up.
1. Wire Harness
–
Only one light does not light.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
*1: Inspect wiper arm and blade set position
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Wiper and washers do not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
WIPER Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Wiper Switch
Wiper Motor
Wire Harness
Wipers do not operate in LO or HI.
1. Wiper Switch
2. Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness
BE–40
BE–40
–
Wipers do not operate in INT.
1. Wiper Switch
2. Wiper Motor
3. Wire Harness
BE–40
BE–40
–
Washer motor does not operate.
1. Washer Switch
2. Washer Motor
3. Wire Harness
BE–40
BE–40
–
Wipers do not operate when washer switch in ON.
1. Washer Motor
2. Wire Harness
BE–40
–
Author:
–
BE–40
BE–40
–
Date:
2225
BE–6
BODY ELECTRICAL
Washer fluid does not operate.
In wiper switch HI position, the wiper blade is in contact with
the body.
When the wiper switch is OFF, the wiper blade does not
retract or the retract position is wrong.
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
1. Washer Hose and Nozzle
–
*1Wiper
1.
Switch
2. Wire Harness
BE–40
–
COMBINATION METER
METER, GAUGES AND ILLUMINATION:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Tachometer, Fuel Gauge and Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
do not operate.
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–46
–
Speedometer does not operate.
1. No.1 Vehicle Speed Sensor
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
BE–47
BE–46
–
1. Igniter
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
IG–1
IG–1
BE–46
–
Fuel Gauge does not operate or abnormal operation.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Fuel Receiver Gauge
Fuel Sender Gauge
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
BE–47
BE–47
BE–46
–
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge does not operate or abnormal
operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
Engine Coolant Temperature Receiver Gauge
Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Gauge
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
BE–47
BE–47
BE–46
–
All illumination lights do not light up.
1. TAIL Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Light Control Rheostat
3. Wire Harness
Brightness does not change even when rheostat turned.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Only one illumination light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Tachometer does not operate.
(5S–FE)
(1MZ–FE)
–
BE–47
–
COMBINATION METER
WARNING LIGHTS:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Warning lights do not light up. (Except Discharge, Open Door and
SRS)
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–46
–
Low Oil Pressure warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–46
–
Fuel Level warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Fuel Level Warning Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–46
–
ABS warning light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. ABS ECU
3. Wire Harness
–
IN–31
–
Author:
Date:
2226
BE–7
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–47
–
1.
2.
3.
4.
IGN Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Bulb
Wire Harness
Generator
–
–
–
CH–1
CH–1
Light Failure warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Bulb
Light Failure Sensor
Bulb Check Relay
Wire Harness
Taillight system
–
BE–37
BE–47
–
BE–24
Brake warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Bulb
Parking Brake Switch
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
Bulb Check Relay
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–47
BE–47
BE–46
–
SRS Warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
ECU–B Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Bulb
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
DI–626
BE–46
–
Open Door warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
Bulb
Door Courtesy Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–32
BE–46
–
Washer Level warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Washer Fluid Level Warning Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–47
BE–46
–
Seat Belt warning light does not light up.
Discharge warning light does not light up.
(5S–FE)
(1MZ–FE)
COMBINATION METER
INDICATOR LIGHTS:
Symptom
Suspect Area
1. Bulb
2. O/D OFF Switch
See page
3. Meter Circuit Plate
4. Wire Harness
–
DI–431
DI–487
BE–46
–
Cruise Control indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Cruise Control ECU
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
IN–31
BE–46
–
High beam indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
Headlight System
–
BE–46
–
BE–22
Turn indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning System
–
BE–46
–
BE–29
O/D OFF indicator light does not light up.
Author:
(A140E)
(A541E)
Date:
2227
BE–8
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
4. Wire Harness
–
BE–46
DI–424
DI–479
–
Only one shift indicator does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Meter Circuit Plate
–
BE–46
Malfunction indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
ECM
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–46
–
SLIP indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Traction ECU
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–46
–
TRAC OFF indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Traction ECU
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–46
–
Security indicator light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Security ECU
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–46
–
Indicator lights do not light up. (Except Turn, Hi–beam and
security)
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Wire Harness
Shift indicator lights do not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Park/Neutral Position Switch
(A140E)
(A541E)
–
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
All defogger systems do not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DEFOG M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
HTR Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Defogger Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Defogger Switch
Wire Harness
–
–
BE–56
BE–56
–
Rear window defogger does not operate.
1. Defogger Wire
2. Choke Coil
3. Wire Harness
BE–56
–
–
Mirror defogger does not operate.
1. MIR/HTR Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Mirror Defogger
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–56
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Power window does not operate (ALL).
(Power Door Lock does not operate)
1. POWER M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Power Main Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–60
–
Power window does not operate (ALL).
(Power Door Lock is normal)
1. Ignition Switch
2. Power Window Master Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–14
BE–60
–
”One Touch Power Window System” does not operate.
1. Power Window Master Switch
BE–60
Only one window glass does not move.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Power Window Master Switch
Power Window Switch
Power Window Motor
Wire Harness
BE–60
BE–60
BE–60
–
”Window Lock System” does not operate.
1. Power Window Master Switch
BE–60
Author:
Date:
2228
BE–9
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
”Window Lock Illumination” does not light up.
1. Power Window Master Switch
BE–60
Key–off power window does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
–
BE–60
BE–14
BE–32
–
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Ignition Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Wire Harness
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
”Door lock system” does not operate at all.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
POWER M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
CIG Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
DOOR Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
–
–
–
BE–70
–
Door lock system does not operate by manual switch.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Power Window Master Switch
Door Lock Manual Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
BE–60
BE–70
BE–70
–
Door lock system does not operate by door key.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
Door Lock Link Disconnected
BE–70
BE–70
–
–
Fault in 2–Operation unlock function of Driver’s side door key lock
and unlock switch.
1. Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
2. Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
BE–70
BE–70
–
Fault in key confine prevention operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
BE–70
BE–14
BE–32
–
Only one door lock does not operate.
1. Door Lock Motor
2. Wire Harness
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Key Unlock Warning Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Wire Harness
BE–70
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Sliding roof system does not operate.
(Door Lock does not operate)
1. POWER M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Power Main Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–60
–
Sliding roof system does not operate.
(Door Lock is normal)
1.
2.
3.
4.
Ignition Switch
Sliding Roof Control Relay and Switch
Sliding Roof Motor and Limit Switch
Wire Harness
BE–14
BE–74
BE–74
–
Sliding roof system operates abnormally.
1. Sliding Roof Control Relay and Switch
2. Sliding Roof Motor and Limit Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–74
BE–74
–
Sliding roof system stops operation half way.
(Stones of foreign material trapped in motor assembly)
1. Sliding Roof Control Relay and Switch
2. Sliding Roof Motor and Limit Switch
3. Wire Harness
BE–74
BE–74
–
”Key–off Sliding Roof” operation does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
–
–
BE–14
BE–14
–
DOME Fuse (E/G Room J/B No.2)
GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Ignition Switch
Integration Relay (I/P J/B No.1)
Wire Harness
Author:
Date:
2229
BE–10
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BODY ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Power seat does not operate.
(Door lock system does not operate)
1. POWER M–Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Wire Harness
–
–
Power seat does not operate.
(Door lock system is normal)
1. Power Seat Swtich (D,P)
2. Wire Harness
BE–78
–
”Slide operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch (D, P)
2. Wire Harness
3. Slide Motor (D, P)
BE–78
–
BE–78
”Lifter Operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch (D, P)
2. Wire Harness
3. Lifter Motor (D, P)
BE–78
–
BE–78
”Reclining Operation” does not operate.
1. Power Seat Switch (D, P)
2. Wire Harness
3. Reclining Motor (D, P)
BE–78
–
BE–78
(D): Driver’s seat
(P): Passenger’s seat
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspect Area
Mirror does not operate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Mirror operates abnormally.
1. Mirror Switch
2. Mirror Motor
3. Wire Harness
See page
CIG Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
Mirror Switch
Mirror Motor
Wire Harness
–
BE–83
BE–83
–
BE–83
BE–83
–
Author:
Date:
2230
BE–11
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER SOURCE
POWER SOURCE
BE0A0–03
LOCATION
Engine Room Relay Block No.1
Engine Room Junction
Block No.2
Engine Room Relay Block No.2
Instrument Panel Junction Block No.1
Turn Signal Flasher
Z19043
Author:
Date:
2231
BE–12
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER OUTLET
POWER OUTLET
BE0A1–03
LOCATION
Power Outlet
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
PWR OUTLET Fuse
N20688
Author:
Date:
2232
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
BE–13
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH
BE0A2–03
LOCATION
Key Unlock Warning Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
Integration Relay
Ignition Switch
N20687
Author:
Date:
2233
BE–14
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
BE0A3–02
INSPECTION
1.
ACC
ON
LOCK
4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5
START
N14824
INSPECT IGNITION SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
LOCK
–
ACC
2–3
Continuity
ON
2–3–4
6–7
Continuity
START
1–2–4
6–7–8
Continuity
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
OFF
ON
2 1
INSPECT KEY UNLOCK WARNING SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
OFF (Key removed)
–
ON (Key set)
1–2
Specified condition
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20125
3.
10
6
5
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
Key unlock warning system:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE A) OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminals 5, 6 and 10.
Check the buzzer sounds.
N20126
(d)
10
6
5
(e)
1
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 6.
Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
N20127
Author:
Date:
2234
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
BE–15
(f)
10 6
5
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
6.
(g) Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 5.
(h) Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
1
N20128
4.
10
6
5
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
Key unlock warning system:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE B) OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminals 5, 6 and 10.
Check the buzzerr sounds.
N20129
(d)
10
6
5
(e)
1
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 6.
Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
N20130
(f)
10
6
5
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
6.
(g) Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 5.
(h) Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
1
N20131
5.
10
6
5
(a)
1
(b)
(c)
Key unlock warning system:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE C) OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminals 5, 6 and 10.
Check the buzzerr sounds.
N20132
Author:
Date:
2235
BE–16
BODY ELECTRICAL
(d)
(e)
10
6
5
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 6.
Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
1
N20133
(f)
10
6
5
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
6.
(g) Disconnect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal 5.
(h) Check that the buzzerr stops sounding.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
1
N20134
6.
(a)
Junction block side:
12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE A) CIRCUIT
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and inspect the connector on the junction block side.
3 2 1
N20135
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 – Ground
4 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
2 – Ground
4 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch OFF
No continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch ON
Continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch OFF
No continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch ON
Continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch OFF (Seat belt unfastened)
No continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch ON (Seat belt fastened)
Continuity
10 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
Author:
Date:
2236
BODY ELECTRICAL
(b)
Wire harness side:
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
BE–17
Disconnect the connector from the integration relay and
inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
1 23 4
N20136
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 – Ground
Light control switch OFF
No continuity
1 – Ground
Light control switch HEAD or TAIL
Continuity
4 – Ground
Light control switch OFF or TAIL
No continuity
4 – Ground
Light control switch HEAD
Continuity
2 – Ground
3 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
If the circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new
one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
7.
(a)
Junction block side:
12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE B) CIRCUIT
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and inspect the connector on the junction block side.
3 2 1
N20135
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 – Ground
All door courtesy switches OFF (Except Driver’s
Door/ Door closed)
No continuity
2 – Ground
One of the door courtesy switches ON (Except
Driver’s Door/ Door opened)
Continuity
4 – Ground
Door courtesy switches except that of the driver’s
door OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
4 – Ground
One of the door courtesy switches except that of
the driver’s door ON (Door opened)
Continuity
Author:
Date:
2237
BE–18
BODY ELECTRICAL
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch OFF
No continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch ON
Continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch ON (Door opened)
Continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch OFF (Seat belt unfastened)
No continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch ON (Seat belt fastened)
Continuity
10 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
11 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK
No voltage
11 – Ground
Ignition switch ACC or ON
Battery positive voltage
(b)
Wire harness side:
1
–
2 3 4 5 6
Disconnect the connector from the integration relay and
inspect the connectors on the wire harness side.
7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
Connector ”A”
Wire harness side:
1 2 3
eh–25–1
h–4–1
4
Connector ”B”
N20137
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
A3 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
A5 – Ground
Driver’s door unlock detection switch OFF (Door
locked)
No continuity
A5 – Ground
Driver’s door unlock detection switch ON (Door
unlocked)
Continuity
A6 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
Author:
Date:
2238
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
A6 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
A7 – Ground
Passenger’s door unlock detection switch OFF
(Door locked)
No continuity
A7 – Ground
Passenger’s door unlock detection switch ON
(Door unlocked)
Continuity
A9 – Ground
Rear door unlock detection switch OFF (Door
locked)
No continuity
A9 – Ground
Rear door unlock detection switch ON (Door
unlocked)
Continuity
Constant
Continuity
A16 – Ground
Door lock manual switch OFF or UNLOCK
No continuity
A16 – Ground
Door lock manual switch LOCK
Continuity
A17 – Ground
Door lock manual switch OFF or LOCK
No continuity
A17 – Ground
Door lock manual switch UNLOCK
Continuity
A18 – Ground
Driver’s and passenger’s door key lock and
unlock switch OFF or UNLOCK
No continuity
A18 – Ground
Driver’s or passenger’s door key lock and unlock
switch LOCK
Continuity
A19 – Ground
Driver’s door key lock and unlock switch OFF or
LOCK
No continuity
A19 – Ground
Driver’s door key lock and unlock switch
UNLOCK
Continuity
A20 – Ground
Passenger’s door key lock and unlock switch
OFF or LOCK
No continuity
A20 – Ground
Passenger’s door key lock and unlock switch
UNLOCK
Continuity
A1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
B1 – Ground
Light control switch OFF
No voltage
B1 – Ground
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
Battery positive voltage
B4 – Ground
Light control switch OFF or TAIL
No voltage
B4 – Ground
Light control switch HEAD
Battery positive voltage
B2 – Ground
B3 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
A11 – A12
A12 – A25
BE–19
If the circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new
one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
8.
(a)
Junction block side:
12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE C) CIRCUIT
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and inspect the connector on the junction block side.
3 2 1
N20135
Author:
Date:
2239
BE–20
BODY ELECTRICAL
Tester connection
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
Condition
Specified condition
2 – Ground
All door courtesy switches OFF (Except Driver’s
Door/ Door closed)
No continuity
2 – Ground
One of the door courtesy switches ON (Except
Driver’s Door/ Door opened)
Continuity
4 – Ground
Door courtesy switches except that of the driver’s
door OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
4 – Ground
One of the door courtesy switches except that of
the driver’s door ON (Door opened)
Continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch OFF
No continuity
5 – Ground
Key unlock warning switch ON
Continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door closed)
No continuity
6 – Ground
Driver’s door courtesy switch ON (Door opened)
Continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch OFF (Seat belt unfastened)
No continuity
8 – Ground
Buckle switch ON (Seat belt fastened)
Continuity
10 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
7 – Ground
9 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
11 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK
No voltage
11 – Ground
Ignition switch ACC or ON
Battery positive voltage
(b)
Wire harness side:
Disconnect the connector from the integration relay and
inspect the connectors on the wire harness side.
1 2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Connector ”A”
Wire harness side:
1 2 3 4
Connector ”B”
N20138
Author:
Date:
2240
BODY ELECTRICAL
Tester connection
–
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY UNLOCK WARNING
SWITCH
Condition
Specified condition
A1 – Ground
Door lock manual switch OFF or UNLOCK
No continuity
A1 – Ground
Door lock manual switch LOCK
Continuity
A2 – Ground
Door lock manual switch OFF or LOCK
No continuity
A2 – Ground
Door lock manual switch UNLOCK
Continuity
A3 – Ground
Driver’s and passenger’s door key lock and
unlock switch OFF or UNLOCK
No continuity
A3 – Ground
Driver’s or passenger’s door key lock and unlock
switch LOCK
Continuity
A4 – Ground
Driver’s door key lock and unlock switch OFF or
LOCK
No continuity
A4 – Ground
Driver’s door key lock and unlock switch
UNLOCK
Continuity
A5 – Ground
Passenger’s door key lock and unlock switch
OFF or LOCK
No continuity
A5 – Ground
Passenger’s door key lock and unlock switch
UNLOCK
Continuity
Constant
Continuity
A8 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
A8 – Ground
Passenger’s door courtesy switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
A9 – Ground
Driver’s door unlock detection switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
A9 – Ground
Driver’s door unlock detection switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
A10 – Ground
Passenger’s door unlock detection switch OFF
(Door closed)
No continuity
A10 – Ground
Passenger’s door unlock detection switch ON
(Door opened)
Continuity
A11 – Ground
Rear door unlock detection switch OFF (Door
closed)
No continuity
A11 – Ground
Rear door unlock detection switch ON (Door
opened)
Continuity
A12 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
A13 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
B1 – Ground
Light control switch OFF
No voltage
B1 – Ground
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
Battery positive voltage
B4 – Ground
Light control switch OFF or TAIL
No voltage
B4 – Ground
Light control switch HEAD
Battery positive voltage
B2 – Ground
B3 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
A6 – A7
BE–21
If the circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new
one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
Author:
Date:
2241
BE–22
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE0A4–02
LOCATION
E/G Room J/B No.2
HEAD LH Fuse (USA)
HEAD RH Fuse (USA)
HEAD LH (UPR) Fuse (CANADA)
HEAD RH (UPR) Fuse (CANADA)
DOME Fuse
ECU–B Fuse
Headlight Control Relay
Daytime Resister
E/G Room R/B No.2 (CANADA)
HEAD LH (LWR) Fuse
HEAD RH (LWR) Fuse
DRL No.2 Fuse
Daytime Running Light Relay No.4
Automatic Light
Control Sensor
Headlight
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
GAUGE Fuse
TAIL Fuse
Taillight Control Relay
Integration Relay
Ignition Switch
Combination Switch
Light Control Switch
Headlight Dimmer Switch
Daytime Running
Light Relay
Door Courtesy Switch
Light Failure Sensor
Taillight
I08436
Author:
Date:
2242
BE–23
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE0A5–02
COMPONENTS
Combination Switch
Light Control Switch
Headlight Dimmer Switch
Switch Body
Spiral Cable
Combination Switch
Wiper and Washer Switch
N18012
Author:
Date:
2243
BE–24
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE10D–01
INSPECTION
1.
Hi beam
HEAD
TAIL
OFF
Flash
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
–
TAIL
14 – 16
Continuity
HEAD
13 – 14 – 16
Continuity
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH CONTINUITY
8 7
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Low beam
16 – 17
Continuity
High beam
7 – 16
Continuity
Flash
7 – 8 – 16
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
17
16
14 13
N20149
3.
1
2
4
2
1
4
3
3
INSPECT HEADLIGHT CONTROL RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Z08521
4.
2
1
3
5
5
2
1
3
INSPECT TAILLIGHT CONTROL RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
N14863
5.
2
4
1
3
2
4
1
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1 – 4, 2 – 4
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 2 and 4.
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
3
Z08523
Author:
Date:
2244
BE–25
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
6.
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (MAIN)
CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
Wire harness side:
I08219
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2 – Ground
Light control switch position OFF or TAIL
No continuity
2 – Ground
Light control switch position HEAD
Continuity
3 – Ground
Headlight dimmer switch position
Low beam
No continuity
3 – Ground
Headlight dimmer switch position
High beam of Flash
Continuity
4 – Ground
Brake fluid level warning position OFF
No continuity
4 – Ground
Brake fluid level warning position ON
Continuity
12 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
14 – Ground
Parking brake switch position OFF
(Parking brake lever released)
No continuity
14 – Ground
Parking brake switch position ON
(Parking brake lever pulled up)
Continuity
17 – Ground
Light control switch position OFF or HEAD
No voltage
17 – Ground
Light control switch position TAIL
Continuity
20 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
21 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
13 – Ground
Engine Stop
No voltage
13 – Ground
Engine Running
Battery positive voltage
16 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
18 – Ground
Ground terminal 19
Battery positive voltage
19 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
22 – Ground
Constant
Battery positive voltage
23 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
No voltage
23 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON or START
Battery positive voltage
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new one.
If circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
Author:
Date:
2245
BE–26
BODY ELECTRICAL
7.
2
3
1
4
2
1
3
4
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT NO.4 RELAY
CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
3–4
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 3 and 4.
1–2
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Z08559
8.
2 1
INSPECT DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RESISTER CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Approx. 250mΩ
If continuity is not as specified, replace the resistor.
9.
INSPECT LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF SYSTEM
(See Integration relay circuit on page BE–14)
N20139
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Turn the light control switch to OFF.
Parking brake lever released.
Gradually cover the top of the sensor.
Verify that the lights should turn ON the accessory lights
and the headlights.
11.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL
Gradually expose the sensor.
Verify that the lights should turn OFF the headlights and
the accessory lights.
INSPECT LIGHT–OFF CONDITION
Turn the ignition switch ON.
Gradually cover the top of the sensor.
Lights auto ON:
INSPECT LIGHTS–ON CONDITION
Open the driver’s door while the ignition switch is OFF.
Turn the light control switch to OFF leaving the door open
and cover the top of the sensor, and verify that the lights
go on when the ignition switch is turned ON.
I08422
12.
(a)
(b)
I08423
13.
(a)
(b)
Author:
Date:
2246
BE–27
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
14.
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
CIRCUIT
Connector disconnected:
Disconnect the connector from the sensor and inspect the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in the table.
Wire harness side:
1234
I01254
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3 – Ground
Constant
Constant
1 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
1 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
5.2 – 9.0 v
If circuit is as specified, perform the inspection on the following
page.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuit connected to
other parts.
15.
4
3
1
2
I01255
INSPECT AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
CIRCUIT
Connector disconnected:
Connect the wire harness side connector to the sensor and inspect wire harness side connector from the back side, as
shown.
HINT:
Ignition switch ON.
Light control switch OFF.
Vehicle’s surroundings are bright.
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
1 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
1 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
9.5 V or more
Vehicle under the direct sun light.
(Sensor is not covered)
Taillight and Headlight are ON.
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the sensor with a new one.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuit connected to
other parts.
Author:
Date:
2247
BE–28
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
HEADLIGHT AND TAILLIGHT SYSTEM
BE0A7–02
ADJUSTMENT
1.
ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIMING
For Adjustment
in Vertical Direction
For Adjustment in
Horizontal Direction
N20156
2.
ADJUST SPIRAL CABLE
(See page SR–16)
Author:
Date:
2248
BE–29
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
BE0A8–03
LOCATION
E/G Room J/B No.2
HORN Fuse
Hazard Warning Switch
Ignition Switch
Turn Signal Light
Instrument Panel J/B
No.1
TURN Fuse
Turn Signal Flasher
Combination Switch
Turn Signal Switch
Turn Signal Light
Z19045
Author:
Date:
2249
BE–30
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
TURN SIGNAL AND HAZARD WARNING SYSTEM
BE0A9–02
INSPECTION
Right
1.
Left
INSPECT TURN SIGNAL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Left turn
1–2
Neutral
–
Right turn
2–3
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
3
2
1
N20150
2.
(a)
3
2
(b)
1
Turn Signal Light Bulbs (21 W)
4 3
BE1843
INSPECT TURN SIGNAL FLASHER OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 3.
Connect the 2 turn signal light bulbs in parallel to each
other to terminals 1 and 3, check that the bulbs flash.
HINT:
The turn signal lights should flash 60 to 120 times per minute.
If one of the front or rear turn signal lights has an open circuit,
the number of flashes will be more than 140 per minute.
If operation is not as specified, replace the flasher.
3.
INSPECT HAZARD WARNING SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Switch OFF
7 – 10
Continuity
Switch ON
5–6–9
7–8
Continuity
Illumination circuit
2–3
Continuity
2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5
Specified condition
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20140
Author:
Date:
2250
BE–31
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AA–03
LOCATION
E/G Room J/B No.2
DOME Fuse
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
Integration Relay
Map Light
Dome Light
Door Courtesy Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Luggage Compartment
Door Courtesy Switch
Z19046
Author:
Date:
2251
BE–32
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AB–03
INSPECTION
w/ Sliding roof:
2
1
1.
INSPECT MAP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
OFF
–
ON
1–2
Specified condition
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the light assembly or
bulb.
w/o Sliding roof:
1
2
N21873
2.
(a)
(b)
2
Ohmmeter
INSPECT DOME LAMP SWITCH
Disconnect the connector from the dome lamp.
Turn the dome lamp switch ON, check that continuity exists between terminal 2 and body ground.
N20157
(c)
Turn the dome lamp switch DOOR, check that there is
continuity exists between terminal 1 and 2.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
2
Ohmmeter
1
N20158
3.
(a)
ON
Ohmmeter
OFF
INSPECT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH CONTINUITY
Check that continuity exists between terminal and the
switch body with the switch ON (switch pin released:
opened door).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between terminal and the
switch body with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed in:
closed doors).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20159
Author:
Date:
2252
BE–33
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
INTERIOR LIGHT SYSTEM
4.
ON
OFF
I01447
INSPECT LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Check that continuity exists between terminal and switch
body with the switch ON (switch pin released: opened
door).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between the terminal and
switch body with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed in:
closed door).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
5.
INSPECT ILLUMINATED ENTRY SYSTEM
(See Integration relay circuit on page BE–14)
Author:
Date:
2253
BE–34
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AC–02
LOCATION
Instrument Panel
J/B No.1
GAUGE Fuse
Ignition Switch
Back–up Light
1MZ–FE engine:
5S–FE engine:
Back–up Light
Switch
Back–up Light Switch
PNP Switch
Z19047
Author:
Date:
2254
BE–35
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
BACK–UP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AD–02
INSPECTION
INSPECT BACK–UP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Tester connection
Free
–
Push
1–2
Specified condition
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Push
Free
Condition
N14065
Author:
Date:
2255
BE–36
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AE–02
LOCATION
Stop Light Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
STOP Fuse
Hi–Mounted Stop Light
Stop Light
Light Failure Sensor
Z19048
Author:
Date:
2256
BE–37
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
BE0AF–02
INSPECTION
w/o Cruise control:
Free
1.
Pushed in
2
1
w/ Cruise control:
Free
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Switch pin free
1–2
Continuity
Switch pin pushed in
1–2
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
w/ Cruise control:
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Pushed in
1
2
w/o Cruise control:
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
Switch pin free
1–2
Continuity
Switch pin pushed in
1–2
No continuity
Switch pin free
3–4
No continuity
Switch pin pushed in
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
3
4
N18026
3.
1
INSPECT HI–MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
CONTINUITY
Using the ohmmeter, check that continuity exists between terminals.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the bulb or light assembly.
2
N20208
Author:
Date:
2257
BE–38
BODY ELECTRICAL
STOP LIGHT SYSTEM
4.
INSPECT LIGHT FAILURE RELAY CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect the connector on the wire harness side, as shown.
Wire harness side:
5 4
–
3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6
e–12–2–B
N20209
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1 – Ground
Constant
Continuity*
2 – Ground
Constant
Continuity*
9 – Ground
Constant
Continuity*
11 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
3 – Ground
Light control switch OFF
No voltage
3 – Ground
Light control switch TAIL or HEAD
Battery positive voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
7 – Ground
Stop light switch OFF
No voltage
7 – Ground
Stop light switch ON
Battery positive voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
*: There is resistance because this circuit is grounded through
the bulb.
If the circuit is as specified, replace the relay.
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
Author:
Date:
2258
BE–39
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
BE0AG–03
LOCATION
Wiper Motor
Washer Tank
Washer Motor
Wiper and Washer Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
WIPER Fuse
Z19049
Author:
Date:
2259
BE–40
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
BE0AH–03
w/o Timer
OFF
INT
LO
HI
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH
CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
OFF
7 – 16
Continuity
INT
7 – 16
Continuity
LO
7 – 17
Continuity
HI
8 – 17
Continuity
Washer ON
2 – 11
Continuity
Washer ON
w/ Timer
OFF
INT
LO
HI
Specified condition
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Washer ON
8 7
17
2
11
16
N20218
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2
7
(d)
16
INSPECT INTERMITTENT OPERATION
Turn the wiper switch to INT position.
Turn the intermittent time control switch to FAST position.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
16 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal 7 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that
the meter needle indicates battery positive voltage.
N20210
(e)
7
2
After connecting terminal 16 to terminal 17, connect it to
terminal 2, check the voltage rises from 0 volts to battery
positive voltage within the time, as shown in the table.
17
INT time control
switch position
16
Voltage
Approx. 2 sec.
Battery positive voltage
FAST
N20211
0V
10.7 ± 5 sec.
Battery positive voltage
SLOW
0V
3.3 ± 1 sec.
Non variable type
Battery positive voltage
0V
If operation is not as specified, replace the wiper and washer
switch.
Author:
Date:
2260
BE–41
BODY ELECTRICAL
3.
(a)
2
7
(b)
(c)
16
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
INSPECT WASHER LINKED OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
16 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal 7 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Push in the washer switch, and check that the voltage
changes as shown in the chart.
Washer Switch ON
N20210
OFF
Less than 1 sec.
Approx. 3 sec.
Battery positive
Voltage
0V
N11301
If operation is not as specified, replace the wiper and washer
switch.
4.
Low speed:
INSPECT FRONT WIPER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 5 and
the negative (–) lead to terminal 4, check that the motor operates at low speed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
5
4
N20151
Author:
Date:
2261
BE–42
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
5.
High speed:
INSPECT FRONT WIPER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 3 and
the negative (–) lead to terminal 4, check that the motor operates at high speed.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
3
4
N20152
6.
(a)
Stopping in stop position:
INSPECT FRONT WIPER MOTOR OPERATION
Operate the motor at low speed and stop the motor operation anywhere except in the stop position by disconnecting positive (+) lead from terminal 5.
5
4
N20153
Author:
Date:
2262
BE–43
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
(b)
(c)
3
Connect terminals 3 and 5.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and negative (–) lead to terminal 4, check that the motor
stops running in the stop position after the motor operates
again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
2
5
4
N20154
7.
INSPECT WASHER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 2 and
the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the motor operates.
NOTICE:
These tests must be performed quickly (within 20 seconds)
to prevent the coil from burning out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
2
1
2
1
N20155
Author:
Date:
2263
BE–44
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
COMBINATION METER
BE0AI–03
LOCATION
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
E/G Room J/B No.2
ECU–B Fuse
DOME Fuse
Washer Fluid Level
Warning Switch
Combination Meter
Bulb Check Relay
ECM
ABS ECU
Light Control Rheostat
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
GAUGE Fuse
TAIL Fuse
IGN Fuse
Integration Relay
Z19050
Author:
Date:
2264
BE–45
BODY ELECTRICAL
PKB Switch
–
COMBINATION METER
Door Courtesy Switch
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Fuel Sender Gauge
Fuel Level Warning Switch
Light Failure Sensor
5S–FE engine:
1MZ–FE engine:
Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Engine Coolant
Temperature Gauge
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
Low Oil Pressure
Warning Switch
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Park/Neutral Position Switch
Z19055
Author:
Date:
2265
BE–46
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
BE0AJ–03
CIRCUIT
Connector ”A”
1 2 3 4 5 6
Connector ”B”
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Connector ”C”
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
J–13–1–A
C7
E
T
7 8 9 10 11 1213
J–16–1
B3
C5
A2
A1
C8
F
1 2 3 4 5 6
Connector ”C”
Connector ”B”
J–13–1
Connector ”A”
B15
C6
S
B14
ODOMETER
Fuel Level Warning
Seat Belt Warning
ABS Warning
Low Oil Pressure Warning
Cruise Control Indicator
Malfunction Indicator
O/D OFF Indicator
Light Failure Warning
Brake Warning
SLIP Indicator
TRAC Indicator
Washer Level Warning
Discharge Warning
A13
B2
C1
B1
C9
A6
A11
A7
A10
A8
A9
Bulb Check
Relay
Right Turn Indicator
Left Turn Indicator
Security Indicator
L
2
D
N
R
P
Illumination
C13
B8
B11
B12
Hi–Beam Indicator
Open Door Warning
SRS Warning
B6
A4
C4
B5
C10
C2
A12
A3
B7
C3
A5
C11
B4
No.
A
B16
B
C12
B9
B10
B13
C
F : Fuel Gauge
E : Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
T : Tachometer
S : Speedometer
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Wire Harness Side
Engine coolant temperature sender gauge
Ground
Light failure sensor
Integration relay
Traction ECU
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
O/D OFF switch (A/T)
IGN fuse
Turn signal switch
ST relay
Fuel sender gauge
Generator
Oil pressure switch
Fuel sender gauge
Parking brake switch and brake fluid level warning switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Door courtesy switch
DOME fuse
ECU–B fuse
Airbag sensor assembly
ECM
No.1 Vehicle speed sensor
Ground
Turn signal switch
ECM
Traction ECU
ABS ECU
Ground
No.1 Vehicle speed sensor
GAUGE fuse
Igniter
Security ECU
Cruise control ECU
Washer fluid level warning switch
Light control rheostat
TAIL fuse
N20107 N20108
Z18937
Author:
Date:
2266
BE–47
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
BE0AK–03
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SPEEDOMETER ON–VEHICLE
Using a speedometer tester, inspect the speedometer for allowable indication error and check the operation of the odometer.
HINT:
Tire wear and tire over or under inflation will increase the indication error.
If error is excessive, replace the speedometer.
USA (mph)
CANADA (km/h)
Standard indication
Allowable range
Standard indication
Allowable range
20
18 – 24
20
40
38 – 44
40
38 – 46
60
56 – 66
60
57.5 – 67
80
78 – 88
80
77 – 88
100
98 – 110
100
96 – 109
120
118 – 132
120
115 – 130
140
134 – 151.5
160
153 – 173
2.
(a)
3
(b)
1
(c)
(d)
2
N02332
17 – 24
INSPECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the tester to terminal
3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Rotate the shaft.
Check that there is voltage change from approx. 0 V to
11 V or more between terminals 2 and 3.
HINT:
The voltage change should be performed 4 times for every revolution of the speed sensor shaft.
If operation is not as specified, replace the sensor.
3.
INSPECT TACHOMETER ON–VEHICLE
(a) Connect a tune–up test tachometer, and start the engine.
NOTICE:
Reversing the connection of the tachometer will damage the transistors and diodes inside.
When removing or installing the tachometer, be careful not to drop or subject it to heavy shocks.
Author:
Date:
2267
BE–48
BODY ELECTRICAL
(b)
Ignition
Switch
–
COMBINATION METER
Compare the tester with tachometer indications.
DC 13.5 V 25°C at (77 °F)
Standard indication
Allowable range
700
630 – 770
1,000
900 – 1,100
2,000
1,850 – 2,150
3,000
2,800 – 3,200
4,000
3,800 – 4,200
5,000
4,800 – 5,200
6,000
5,750 – 6,250
7,000
6,700 – 7,300
4.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the receiver gauge
needle indicates EMPTY.
(c)
Connect terminals 2 and 3 on the wire harness side connector through a 3.4–W test bulb.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the bulb lights up
and the receiver gauge needle moves towards the full
side.
Fuel
Gauge
Battery
N20160
Ignition
Switch
(d)
Fuel
Gauge
Battery
1
2
4
BE1206 Ie–5–1–A
3
5
Z05727
HINT:
Because of the silicon oil in the gauge, it will take a short time
for needle to stabilize.
If operation is not as specified, inspect the receiver gauge resistance.
5.
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
A
B
C
Tester connection
Resistance (Ω)
A–B
Approx. 126.2
A–C
Approx. 280.5
B–C
Approx. 154.3
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver
gauge.
N20212
Author:
Date:
2268
BE–49
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
6.
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals 2 and 3 for each
float position.
F
1/2
E 3
1
2
N20161
Float position mm (in.)
Resistance (Ω)
F: Approx. –91.1 (–3.587)
Approx. 3.0
1/2: Approx. –34.2 (–1.346)
Approx. 31.7
E: Approx. 30.8 (1.213)
Approx. 110.0
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the sender
gauge.
7.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Connect terminals 1 and 3 on the wire harness side connector.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the warning light
lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or inspect wire
harness.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
2
1
4
3
5
Z05730
BE1217 Ie–5–1–A
3
1
8.
(a)
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
Apply battery positive voltage between terminals 1 and 3
through a 3.4–W test bulb, check that the bulb lights up.
HINT:
It takes a short time for the bulb to light up.
N20213
1
3
(b) Submerge the switch in fuel, check that the bulb goes out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the sender gauge.
N20214
9.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
Ignition
Switch
Battery
(a)
(b)
Sender
Gauge
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the receiver
gauge needle indicates COOL.
N20215
Author:
Date:
2269
BE–50
BODY ELECTRICAL
Battery
COMBINATION METER
(c)
Ground terminal on the wire harness side connector
through a 3.4–W test bulb.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON, and check that the bulb lights
up and the receiver gauge needle moves to the hot side.
If operation is as specified, replace the sender gauge.
Then, recheck the system.
If operation is not as specified, measure the receiver gauge resistance.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
Ignition
Switch
–
Test Bulb
(3.4 W)
Wire Harness Side
Z15788
10.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
C
B
A
N20216
Tester connection
Resistance (Ω) *
A–B
Approx. 175.7
A–C
Approx. 54.0
B–C
Approx. 229.7
*: This circuit includes the diode.
HINT:
Connect the test leads so that the current from the ohmmeter
can flow according to the above order.
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver
gauge.
11.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between the terminal and gauge body.
Temperature °C (°F)
Resistance (Ω)
50 (122.0)
274
120 (248.0)
26.4
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the engine coolant temperature sender gauge.
N21646
12.
(a)
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the warning switch and
ground terminal on the wire harness side connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
1
Z14205
Author:
Date:
2270
BE–51
BODY ELECTRICAL
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N06640
–
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Disconnect the connector from the switch.
Check that continuity exists between terminal and ground
with the engine stopped.
Check that no continuity exists between terminal and
ground with the engine running.
HINT:
Oil pressure should be over 24.5 kPa (0.25 kgf/cm2, 3.55 psi).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
14.
(a)
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
BE1217
INSPECT BRAKE SYSTEM WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the brake fluid warning
switch.
(b) Release the parking brake pedal.
(c) Connect the terminals on the wire harness side of the level warning switch connector.
(d) Start the engine, check that the warning light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or wire harness.
15.
(a)
(b)
(c)
OFF
ON
2 1
N02346
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
Disconnect the connector.
Check that no continuity exists between the terminals with
the switch OFF (float up).
(d) Use syphon, etc. to take fluid out of the reservoir tank.
(e) Check that continuity exists between the terminals with
the switch ON (float down).
(f)
Pour the fluid back in the reservoir tank.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
16. INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
(a) Check that continuity exists between the terminal and
switch body with the switch ON (switch pin released).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between the terminal and
switch body with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed in).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch or inspect
ground point.
N01212
17.
(a)
INSPECT WASHER FLUID LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connectors from the level warning switch
and parking brake switch.
(b) Connect terminals on the wire harness side connector of
the level warning switch connector.
(c) Remove the GAUGE fuse and turn the ignition switch ON,
and check that the warning light comes on.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
BE1217
Author:
Date:
2271
BE–52
BODY ELECTRICAL
Ohmmeter
OFF
ON
–
COMBINATION METER
18.
(a)
INSPECT WASHER FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
Check that no continuity exists between terminals with the
switch OFF (float up).
(b) Check that continuity exists between terminals with the
switch ON (float down).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20217
19. INSPECT OPEN DOOR WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the door courtesy switch and
ground terminal 1 on the wire harness side, and check that the
warning light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, inspect the bulb or wire harness.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
1
Z05732
20.
(a)
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
BE0044
INSPECT SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
Remove the integration relay from the instrument panel
junction block.
(b) Ground terminal 2 on the integration relay with the connectors still connected.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, inspect the bulb or wire harness.
21.
1
2
OFF
ON
w/o Power seat:
INSPECT BUCKLE SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Check that continuity exists between the terminals on the
switch side connector with the switch ON (belt fastened).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between the terminals on
the switch side connector with the switch OFF (belt unfastened).
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt inner belt.
Z16167
OFF
1
2
ON
N02354
22.
w/ Power seat:
INSPECT BUCKLE SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Check that continuity exists between terminals 1 and 2 on
the switch side connector with the switch ON (belt fastened).
(b) Check that no continuity exists between terminals 1 and
2 on the switch side connector with the switch OFF (belt
unfastened).
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt inner belt.
Author:
Date:
2272
BE–53
BODY ELECTRICAL
23.
Type A:
1
7
(a)
9 10
(b)
(c)
(d)
Type B and C:
1
(e)
7
9
–
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY OF SEAT BELT
WARNING SYSTEM OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminals
1 and 7.
Connect the terminal 7 to terminal 9 through the 3.4–W
test bulb.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
10.
Check that the bulb lights and the buzzer sounds for 4 –
8 seconds.
Return to step (a) and operate the chime again.
10
N20219
(f)
Type A:
1
7
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to terminal
8.
Check that the buzzer stops sounding.
(g)
HINT:
Check the buzzer within a period of 4 to 8 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
24. INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY CIRCUIT
See page BE–14
8 9 10
Type B and C:
1
7
8
9
10
N20220
Author:
Date:
2273
BE–54
BODY ELECTRICAL
25.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and negative lead (–) to terminal 3.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal 2 and negative lead to terminal 3.
Turn the rheostat knob and check that the voltage
changes.
270°
2
3
1
N08958
(a)
B
A
C
(b)
B
A
C
26.
(a)
INSPECT BULB CHECK RELAY OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
C through a 1.4–W test bulb and the negative (–) lead to
terminal B, check that the test bulb does not light up.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
A and check that the test bulb lights up.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Z09972
Author:
Date:
2274
BE–55
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
BE0AL–03
LOCATION
Defogger Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
DEFOG M–Fuse
HTR Fuse
MIR–HTR Fuse
Defogger Relay
Mirror Defogger
Defogger Wire
Z19051
Author:
Date:
2275
BE–56
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
BE0AM–03
INSPECTION
Switch side:
2
1.
INSPECT DEFOGGER SWITCH CONTINUITY
Check that is continuity exists between terminals 2 and 6.
If continuity is not as specified, check the bulb.
1
6 5 4 3
N20315
2.
(a)
5
ON
4
3
N20314
INSPECT DEFOGGER TIMER OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
4 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 3.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
5 through a 3.4–W tester bulb.
(c) Push the defogger switch ON, check that the indicator
light and test bulb light up for 12 to 18 minutes, then the
indicator light and test bulb light goes out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
3.
INSPECT DEFOGGER TIMER CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the switch and inspect the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in the table.
Wire harness side:
1
2
3 4 5 6
S–6–1
Z08467
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
4 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
5 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
No voltage
5 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
Connect terminals 3 and 5.
Defogger system operation is normal
–
If the circuit is not as specified, replace the switch.
4.
1
2
3
5
1
5
2
3
INSPECT DEFOGGER RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
N14863
Author:
Date:
2276
BE–57
BODY ELECTRICAL
5.
(a)
6
4
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
w/ Heater:
INSPECT MIRROR DEFOGGER
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
4 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 6.
Check that the mirror becomes warm.
(b)
HINT:
It takes short time for the mirror to become warm.
N21371
Tester Probe
Heat Wire
Tin Foil
BE4029
At Center
6.
INSPECT DEFOGGER WIRE
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, use a soft, dry cloth, and
wipe the glass in the direction of the wire. Take care
not to damage the wires.
Do not use detergents or glass cleaners with abrasive
ingredients.
When measuring voltage, wind a piece of tin foil
around the top of the negative probe and press the foil
against the wire with your finger, as shown.
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Turn the defogger switch ON.
(c) Inspect the voltage at the center of each heat wire, as
shown.
Voltage
Criteria
Approx. 5V
Okay (No break in wire)
Approx.10V or 0V
Broken wire
BE0123
Several
0 Volt Volts
Broken
Wire
BE0124
HINT:
If there is approximately 10 V, the wire is broken between the
center of the wire and the positive (+) end. If there is no voltage,
the wire is broken between the center of the wire and ground.
(d) Place the voltmeter positive (+) lead against the defogger
positive (+) terminal.
(e) Place the voltmeter negative (–) lead with the foil strip
against the heat wire at the positive (+) terminal end and
slide it toward the negative (–) terminal end.
(f)
The point where the voltmeter deflects from zero to several V is the place where the heat wire is broken.
HINT:
If the heat wire is not broken, the voltmeter indicates 0 V at the
positive (+) end of the heat wire but gradually increases to about
12 V as the meter probe is moved to the other end.
Author:
Date:
2277
BE–58
BODY ELECTRICAL
7.
(a)
Repair Point
(b)
Broken
Wire
(c)
Masking Tape
–
DEFOGGER SYSTEM
IF NECESSARY, REPAIR DEFOGGER WIRE
Clean the broken wire tips with grease, wax and silicone
remover.
Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire to be
repaired.
Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No.
4817).
BE0150
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No. 4817
or equivalent).
Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount to the wire.
After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
Do not repair the defogger wire for at least 24 hours.
BE0151
Author:
Date:
2278
BE–59
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AN–03
LOCATION
Ignition Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
POWER M–Fuse
GAUGE Fuse
Power Main Relay
Integration Relay
Door Courtesy Switch
Power Window Switch
Power Window Switch
Power Window Switch
Power Window Master Switch
Power Window Regulator
Assembly
Power Window Motor
Door Courtesy
Switch
Power Window Regulator Assembly
Power Window Motor
Power Window Regulator Assembly
Power Window Motor
Z19052
Author:
Date:
2279
BE–60
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AO–02
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
6 5 4
3 2 1
141312 1110 9 8 7
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH CONTINUITY
Inspect the front driver’s switch.
Window unlock:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
3–8–9
4–5–6
Continuity
OFF
3–4–5
4–5–6
Continuity
DOWN
6–8–9
3–4–5
Continuity
Window lock:
Switch position
Tester connection
UP
3–8–9
4–5–6
Continuity
OFF
3–4–5
4–5–6
Continuity
DOWN
6–8–9
3–4–5
Continuity
N20559
(b)
Specified condition
Inspect the front passenger’s switch.
Window unlock:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
8 – 9 – 11
4 – 5 – 13
Continuity
OFF
4 – 5 – 11
4 – 5 – 13
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 13
4 – 5 – 11
Continuity
Window lock:
(c)
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
8 – 9 – 11
Continuity
OFF
11 – 13
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 13
Continuity
Inspect the rear left switch.
Window unlock:
Switch position
Tester connection
UP
8 – 9 – 10
4 – 5 – 12
Continuity
OFF
4 – 5 – 10
4 – 5 – 12
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 12
4 – 5 – 10
Continuity
Author: MH
Specified condition
Date: 3/7/02
2280
BE–61
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Window lock:
(d)
Switch position
Tester connection
UP
8 – 9 – 10
Continuity
Specified condition
OFF
10 – 12
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 12
Continuity
Inspect the rear right switch.
Window unlock:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
7–8–9
4 – 5 – 14
Continuity
OFF
4–5–7
4 – 5 – 14
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 14
4–5–7
Continuity
Window lock:
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
7–8–9
Continuity
OFF
7 – 14
Continuity
DOWN
8 – 9 – 14
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the master switch.
2.
Unlock
(a)
(b)
4
8
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH ILLUMINATION
Set the window lock switch to the unlock position.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
8 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 4, and check that
all the illuminations light up.
N02358
(c)
Set the window lock switch to the lock position, check that
all the passenger’s power window switch illuminations go
out.
If operation is not as specified, replace the master switch.
Lock
4
8
N02359
Author:
Date:
2281
BE–62
BODY ELECTRICAL
3
3.
6
(a)
(b)
(c)
Z05738
(d)
3
(e)
6
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Using an ammeter:
INSPECT ONE–TOUCH POWER WINDOW SYSTEM/
CURRENT OF CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the master switch.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 3 on the wire harness side connector and the negative
(–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
6 on the wire harness side connector.
As the window goes down, check that the current flow is
approximately 7 A.
Check that the current increases up to approximately
14.5 A or more when the window stops going down.
HINT:
The circuit breaker opens some 4 – 40 seconds after the window stops going down, so that check must be done before the
circuit breaker operates.
If the operation is as specified, replace the master switch.
Z05739
4.
8
(a)
(b)
(c)
Z05740
8
(d)
(e)
Using an ammeter with a current – measuring probe:
INSPECT ONE–TOUCH POWER WINDOW SYSTEM/
CURRENT OF CIRCUIT
Remove the master switch with connector connected.
Attach a current–measuring probe to terminal 8 of the
wire harness.
Turn the ignition switch ON and set the power window
switch in the down position.
As the window goes down, check that the current flow is
approximately 7 A.
Check that the current increases up to approximately
14.5 A or more when the window stops going down.
HINT:
The circuit breaker opens some 4 – 40 seconds after the window stops going down, so that check must be done before the
circuit breaker operates.
If operation is as specified, replace the master switch.
Z05741
Author: MH
Date: 3/7/02
2282
BE–63
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
5.
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the master switch and inspect
the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in the following page.
Wire harness side:
1 2 3
4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
e–14–1–A
Z05742
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
4 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
8 – Ground
Ignition switch position LOCK or ACC
*No voltage
8 – Ground
Ignition switch position ON
Battery positive voltage
*Exceptions: During 60 seconds after the ignition switch is
turned ON to OFF (ACC) or until driver or a passenger’s door
is opened after the ignition switch is turned ON to OFF (ACC).
If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected
to other parts.
6.
5 4321
Front passenger’s door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
1 – 2, 3 – 4
Continuity
OFF
1 – 2, 3 – 5
Continuity
DOWN
1 – 4, 3 – 5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20560
7.
5 432 1
Rear door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
1 – 3, 4 – 5
Continuity
OFF
1 – 2, 4 – 5
Continuity
DOWN
1 – 2, 3 – 5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20561
8.
1
2
3
5
5
1
2
3
INSPECT POWER MAIN RELAY CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
N14863
Author:
Date:
2283
BE–64
BODY ELECTRICAL
9.
TMMK made:
(a)
2
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Left side door:
INSPECT MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, and check that
the motor turns clockwise.
1
TMC made:
N20555
(b)
Reverse the polarity, and check that the motor turns counterclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
TMMK made:
2
1
TMC made:
N20556
Author: MH
Date: 3/7/02
2284
BE–65
BODY ELECTRICAL
10.
TMMK made:
(a)
2
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Right side door:
INSPECT MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, and check that
the motor turns clockwise.
1
TMC made:
N20557
(b)
Reverse the polarity, and check that the motor turns counterclockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
TMMK made:
2
1
TMC made:
N20558
Author:
Date:
2285
BE–66
BODY ELECTRICAL
11.
1
2
(a)
(b)
(c)
I21314
(d)
(e)
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Driver’s door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the master switch.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 2 on the wire harness side connector and the negative
(–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 on the wire harness side connector, and raise the window to the fully position.
Continue to apply voltage and check that the current
changes to less than 1 A within 4 to 90 seconds.
Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
(f)
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 1, and check that the window begins to
descend.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
2
1
I21315
12.
2
1
(a)
(b)
(c)
I21312
(d)
(e)
Passenger ’s door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the power window switch.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 1 on the wire harness side connector and the negative
(–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 on the wire harness side connector, and raise the window to the fully position.
Continue to apply voltage and check that the current
changes to less than 1 A within 4 to 90 seconds.
Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
Author: MH
Date: 3/7/02
2286
BE–67
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(f)
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 1 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 2, and check that the window begins to
descend.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
2
1
I21313
13.
2
1
I12561
2
1
Rear Door:
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
(a) Disconnect the connector from the power window switch.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 1 on the wire harness side connector and the negative
(–) lead to negative terminal of the battery.
(c) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 on the wire harness side connector, and raise the window to the fully position.
(d) Continue to apply voltage and check that the current
changes to less than 1 A within 4 to 90 seconds.
(e) Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
(f)
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 1, and check that the window begins to
descend.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
I12560
14.
Type B:
(b) Close
(c) Open
A3
N20564
Key–off power window signal:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE B) OPERATION
HINT:
When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the key–off power
window signal.
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal A3 and the negative (–) lead to body ground.
(b) Close the door with ignition switch turned to LOCK or
ACC, and check that the meter needle indicates battery
positive voltage.
(c) Open the door and check that the meter needle indicates
0 V.
Author:
Date:
2287
BE–68
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the meter
needle indicates battery positive voltage again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Type B:
A3
N20565
Type C:
15.
(b) Close
(c) Open
A12
N20566
Key–off power window signal:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (TYPE C) OPERATION
HINT:
When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the key–off power
window signal.
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal A12 and the negative (–) lead to body ground.
(b) Close the door with ignition switch turned to LOCK or
ACC, and check that the meter needle indicates battery
positive voltage.
(c)
Open the door and check that the meter needle indicates
0 V.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the meter
needle indicates battery positive voltage again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
16. INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY CIRCUIT
(See page XX–XXX)
Type C:
A12
N20567
Author: MH
Date: 3/7/02
2288
BE–69
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AP–02
LOCATION
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
POWER M–Fuse
CIG Fuse
DOOR Fuse
Integration Relay
Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
Door Lock Assembly
Door Lock Motor
Door Unlock Detection Switch
Power Window Master Switch
Door Lock Control Switch
Door Lock Assembly
Door Lock Motor
Door Unlock Detection Switch
Door Lock Control Switch
Z19053
Author:
Date:
2289
BE–70
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AQ–02
INSPECTION
1.
N21181
Master switch:
INSPECT DRIVER’S DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
LOCK
2–4
OFF
–
UNLOCK
4–7
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
INSPECT PASSENGER’S DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
LOCK
3–6
OFF
–
UNLOCK
3–5
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20568
3.
OFF
UNLOCK
LOCK
1
2
3
w/ Theft deterrent system:
INSPECT DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
LOCK
2–1
OFF
–
UNLOCK
3–1
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20569
4.
Lock
Unlock
w/o Theft deterrent system:
INSPECT DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
LOCK
2–1
OFF
–
UNLOCK
3–1
Specified condition
Continuity
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N21580
4
5.
1
Lock
Unlock
INSPECT DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
OFF (Door Lock set to
LOCK)
–
ON (Door Lock set to
UNLOCK)
1–4
Specified condition
No continuity
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
N20673
Author:
Date:
2290
BE–71
BODY ELECTRICAL
3
2
3
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
6.
(a)
INSPECT MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, and check that
the door lock link moves to UNLOCK position.
(b) Remove the polarity and check that the door lock link
moves to LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
2
N20570
7.
Front door
Rear door
(a)
(b)
Using an ammeter:
INSPECT PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3.
Connect the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 2 and the negative (–) lead to battery negative (–) terminal, and check that the current changes from approximately 3.2 A to less than 0.5 A within 20 to 70 seconds.
N20571
Front door
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 3, and check that the door lock moves to
the LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
Rear door
N20572
Front door
8.
Rear door
(a)
(b)
Using an ammeter with a current–measuring probe:
INSPECT PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2.
Attach a current–measuring probe to either the positive
(+) lead or the negative (–) lead, and check that the current changes from approximately 3.2 A to less than 0.5 A
within 20 to 70 seconds.
N20573
Front door
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, reverse the polarity, and
check that the door lock moves to the LOCK position.
If operation is not as specified, replace the door lock assembly.
Rear door
N20572
Author:
Date:
2291
BE–72
BODY ELECTRICAL
Type B:
9.
Lock
A25
A12
N20574
Type B:
Unlock
A25
A12
–
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Door lock signal:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (Type B) OPERATION
HINT:
When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the door lock signal.
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal A12 and the negative (–) lead to terminal A25.
(b) Set the door lock control switch to UNLOCK and check
that the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage
for approximately 0.2 seconds.
(c) Reverse the polarity of the voltmeter leads.
(d) Set the door lock control switch to LOCK and check that
the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage for
approximately 0.2 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
N20575
Type C:
10.
Lock
A7 A6
N20576
Type C:
Unlock
A7
A6
Door lock signal:
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (Type C) OPERATION
HINT:
When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the door lock signal.
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to terminal A6 and the negative (–) lead to terminal A7.
(b) Set the door lock control switch to UNLOCK and check
that the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage
for approximately 0.2 seconds.
(c) Reverse the polarity of the voltmeter leads.
(d) Set the door lock control switch to LOCK and check that
the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage for
approximately 0.2 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
11. INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY CIRCUIT
(See page BE–14)
N20577
Author:
Date:
2292
BE–73
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
BE0AR–02
LOCATION
E/G Room J/B No.2
DOME Fuse
Ignition Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
POWER Fuse
GAUGE Fuse
Power Main Relay
Integration Relay
Sliding Control Relay and Switch
Sliding Roof Motor
Limit Switch
Z19490
Author:
Date:
2293
BE–74
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
BE0AS–02
INSPECTION
Wire harness side:
1.
1 2
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF CONTROL RELAY AND
SWITCH CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the relay and switch and inspect
the connector on the wire harness side, as shown in the table.
3
4 5 6 7 8
s–8–1
N21643
TMMK made:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1–5
Constant
Continuity
2 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
3 – Ground
Limit switch No.1 is OFF (Sliding roof is in a
closed position)
No continuity
3 – Ground
Limit switch No.1 is ON (Sliding roof is in an open
position)
Continuity
7 – Ground
Limit switch No.2 is OFF (Sliding roof is in a tilt
up position)
No continuity
7 – Ground
Limit switch No.2 is ON (Sliding roof is in the
open position)
Continuity
8 – Ground
Limit switch No.3 is OFF (Sliding roof is in a
closed position)
No continuity
8 – Ground
Limit switch No.3 is ON (Sliding roof is in an open
position)
Continuity
4 – Ground
Ignition switch is in a LOCK or ACC position
* No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch is in an ON position
Battery positive voltage
TMC made:
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
1–5
Constant
Continuity
2 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
3 – Ground
No.1 limit switch OFF (Sliding roof closed)
No continuity
3 – Ground
No.1 limit switch ON (Sliding roof opened)
Continuity
7 – Ground
No.2 limit switch OFF (Sliding roof tilted up open
approx. 200 mm (7.87 in.)
No continuity
7 – Ground
No.2 limit switch ON (Except for conditions
mentioned above)
Continuity
4 – Ground
Ignition switch LOCK or ACC
* No voltage
4 – Ground
Ignition switch ON
Battery positive voltage
*: Exceptions: For 60 seconds after the ignition switch is turned
ON to OFF (ACC) or until driver or passenger door is opened
after the ignition switch is turned ON to OFF (ACC).
If the circuit is not as specified, replace the relay and switch.
Author:
Date:
2294
BE–75
BODY ELECTRICAL
Webasto type:
2
1
2.
(a)
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the
motor turns counterclockwise (moves to the close and up
side).
DENSO type:
1
2
N21182
(b)
Webasto type:
2
1
Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clockwise
(moves to the open and down side).
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
DENSO type:
1
2
N21183
3.
(a)
INSPECT CIRCUIT BREAKER OPERATION
With the sliding roof in the fully opened position, hold the
sliding roof switch in ”OPEN” position and check that is a
circuit breaker operation noise is heard within 10 to 60 seconds.
Within
10 to 60
seconds
N21644
Author:
Date:
2295
BE–76
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
SLIDING ROOF SYSTEM
(b)
With the sliding roof in fully opened position, hold the sliding roof switch in ”TILT UP” position and check that the
sliding roof begins to close within 60 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the motor.
within 60
seconds
N21645
4.
No.3
Limit Switch
ON
OFF
Switch position
Tester connection
No.1
Limit Switch
No.1 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
3–5
No continuity
No.2
Limit Switch
No.1 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
3–5
Continuity
No.2 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
3–6
No continuity
No.2 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
3–6
Continuity
No.3 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
3–4
No continuity
No.3 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
3–4
Continuity
N21872
5.
ON
OFF
TMMK made:
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF LIMIT SWITCH CIRCUIT
No.1
Limit Switch
No.2
Limit Switch
4 1
5 2
6 3
N21180
Specified condition
TMC made:
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF LIMIT SWITCH CIRCUIT
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
No.1 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
4–5
No continuity
No.1 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
4–5
Continuity
No.2 limit switch OFF
(SW pin released)
4–6
No continuity
No.2 limit switch ON
(SW pin pushed in)
4–6
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
6.
INSPECT KEY–OFF SLIDING ROOF OPERATION
(See integration relay circuit on page BE–14)
Author:
Date:
2296
BE–77
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AT–02
LOCATION
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
CIG Fuse
Lifter Motor
Reclining Motor
Power Seat Switch
Lifter Motor
Sliding Motor
Power Seat Switch
Z19504
Author:
Date:
2297
BE–78
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AU–02
INSPECTION
Lifter Up
1.
(a)
Down
Reclining
Forward
Rear
(b)
Front
Rear
Slide
(c)
5 4
3 21
121110 9 8 7 6
I01932
TMC made:
INSPECT DRIVER’S SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Inspect the slide switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
FRONT
4 – 6, 8 – 11
Continuity
Specified condition
OFF
4 – 6, 6 – 8
Continuity
BACK
6 – 8, 4 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the lifter switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
2 – 11, 3 – 6
Continuity
OFF
3 – 6, 2 – 6
Continuity
DOWN
2 – 6, 3 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the reclining switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FORWARD
1 – 11, 5 – 6
Continuity
OFF
1 – 6, 5 – 6
Continuity
REAR
1 – 6, 5 – 11
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
TMMK made:
INSPECT DRIVER’S SEAT SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Inspect the slide switch.
(b)
(c)
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FRONT
2 – 11, 4 – 7
Continuity
OFF
4 – 11, 4 – 7
Continuity
BACK
2 – 7, 4 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the lifter switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
2 – 5, 4 – 8
Continuity
OFF
4 – 5, 4 – 8
Continuity
DOWN
2 – 8, 4 – 5
Continuity
Inspect the reclining switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FORWARD
2 – 12, 4 – 6
Continuity
OFF
4 – 12, 4 – 6
Continuity
REAR
2 – 6, 4 – 12
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Author:
Date:
2298
BE–79
BODY ELECTRICAL
3.
Lifter Up
(a)
Down
Reclining
Forward
Front
Rear
(b)
Rear
Slide
(c)
5 4
3 21
121110 9 8 7 6
I01932
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
TMC made:
INSPECT PASSENGER’S SEAT CONTINUITY
Inspect the slide switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FRONT
4 – 6, 8 – 11
Continuity
OFF
4 – 6, 6 – 8
Continuity
BACK
6 – 8, 4 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the lifter switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
2 – 6, 3 – 11
Continuity
OFF
3 – 6, 2 – 6
Continuity
DOWN
3 – 6, 2 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the reclining switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FORWARD
5 – 6, 1 – 11
Continuity
OFF
1 – 6, 5 – 6
Continuity
REAR
1 – 6, 5 – 11
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
4.
TMMK made:
INSPECT PASSENGER’S SEAT CONTINUITY
(a) Inspect the slide switch.
(b)
(c)
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FRONT
2 – 11, 4 – 7
Continuity
OFF
4 – 11, 4 – 7
Continuity
BACK
2 – 7, 4 – 11
Continuity
Inspect the lifter switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
UP
2 – 8, 4 – 5
Continuity
OFF
4 – 5, 4 – 8
Continuity
DOWN
2 – 5, 4 – 8
Continuity
Inspect the reclining switch.
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FORWARD
2 – 12, 4 – 6
Continuity
OFF
4 – 12, 4 – 6
Continuity
REAR
2 – 6, 4 – 12
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
(a)
5.
(a)
INSPECT SLIDE MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the
motor turns counterclockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
(b)
2
1
2
1
N21865
Author:
Date:
2299
BE–80
BODY ELECTRICAL
2
6.
1
(a)
(b)
–
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT SLIDE MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 2 and
the negative (–) lead to the battery negative (–) terminal,
then move the seat cushion to the front position.
Continue to apply voltage, check that the current changes
to less than 1 ampere within 4 to 90 seconds.
N21866
2
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 1, check that the seat cushion begins to
move backwards.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
1
N21867
(a)
7.
(a)
INSPECT LIFTER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the
motor turns counterclockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
(b)
2
1
1
2
N21865
2
8.
(a)
1
(b)
INSPECT LIFTER PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 2 and
the negative (–) lead to the battery negative (–) terminal,
then move the seat cushion to the highest position.
Continue to apply voltage, check that the current changes
to less than 1 ampere within 4 to 90 seconds.
N21868
2
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 2 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 1, check that the seat cushion begins to
fall down.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
1
N21869
Author:
Date:
2300
BE–81
BODY ELECTRICAL
(a)
1
POWER SEAT CONTROL SYSTEM
9.
(a)
INSPECT RECLINING MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, check that the
motor turns counterclockwise.
(b) Reverse the polarity, check that the motor turns clockwise.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
(b)
2
–
1
2
N21865
2
10.
1
(a)
(b)
INSPECT RECLINING MOTOR PTC THERMISTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2, the positive (+) lead from the ammeter to terminal 1 and
the negative (–) lead to the battery negative (–) terminal,
then recline the seat back to the most forward position.
Continue to apply voltage, check that the current change
to less than 1 ampere within 4 to 90 seconds.
N21870
2
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the leads from the terminals.
Approximately 60 seconds later, connect the positive (+)
lead from the battery to terminal 1 and the negative (–)
lead to terminal 2, check that the seat back starts to fall
backward.
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat adjuster.
1
N21871
Author:
Date:
2301
BE–82
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AV–03
LOCATION
Mirror Control Switch
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
CIG Fuse
LH Mirror
Mirror Motor
RH Mirror
Mirror Motor
Z19488
Author:
Date:
2302
BE–83
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
BE0AW–03
INSPECTION
R
L
1.
MIRROR
OFF
RIGHT SIDE
LEFT SIDE
UP
LEFT
OFF
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
–
UP
1 – 9, 6 – 10
Continuity
DOWN
1 – 10, 6 – 9
Continuity
LEFT
5 – 9, 6 – 10
Continuity
RIGHT
5 – 10, 6 – 9
Continuity
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
Master switch right side:
INSPECT MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
RIGHT
DOWN
4 3
10 9 8
Master switch left side:
INSPECT MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
2 1
7 6 5
BE2357 h–10–2
Z16591
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
–
UP
6 – 10, 7 – 9
Continuity
DOWN
6 – 9, 7 – 10
Continuity
LEFT
6 – 10, 8 – 9
Continuity
RIGHT
6 – 9, 8 – 10
Continuity
No continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
3.
(a)
TMMK made
(w/o Heater)
1
(b)
2
TMC made
(w/o Heater)
3
2
TMMK made
(w/ Heater)
3
2
(c)
INSPECT MIRROR MOTOR
TMMK made (w/o Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the mirror
turns to left side.
TMC made (w/o Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the mirror
turns to left side.
TMMK made (w/ Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the mirror
turns to left side.
N21184
Author:
Date:
2303
BE–84
BODY ELECTRICAL
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
(d)
Reverse the polarity and check that the mirror turns to
right side.
(e)
TMMK made (w/o Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the
mirror turns upward.
TMC made (w/o Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the
mirror turns upward.
TMMK made (w/ Heater):
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
1 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 2, check that the
mirror turns upward.
TMMK made
(w/o Heater)
TMC made
(w/o Heater)
–
TMMK made
(w/ Heater)
N21185
TMMK made
(w/o Heater)
(f)
(g)
TMC made
(w/o Heater)
TMMK made
(w/ Heater)
N21186
Author:
Date:
2304
BE–85
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
(h)
TMMK made
(w/o Heater)
TMC made
(w/o Heater)
Reverse the polarity, check that the mirror turns downward.
If operation is not as specified, replace the mirror assembly.
TMMK made
(w/ Heater)
N21187
Author:
Date:
2305
BE–86
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE0AX–03
DESCRIPTION
1.
RADIO WAVE BAND
The radio wave bands used in radio broadcasting are as follows:
30 kHz
Frequency
Designation
3 MHz
300 kHz
LF
Modulation method
300 MHz
VHF
HF
MF
AM
Radio wave
30 MHz
FM
Amplitude modulation
Frequency modulation
LF: Low frequency MF: Medium Frequency HF: High Frequency VHF: Very High Frequency
2.
SERVICE AREA
There are great differences in the size of the service area for AM
and FM monaural. Sometimes FM stereo broadcasts cannot be
received even through AM comes in very clearly.
Not only does FM stereo have the smallest service area, but it
also picks up static and other types of interference (”noise”)
easily.
FM (Stereo)
FM (Monaural)
AM
BE2818
3.
RECEPTION PROBLEMS
Besides the problem of static, there are also the problems
called ”fading”, ”multipath” and ”fade out”. These problems are
caused not by electrical noise but by the nature of the radio
waves themselves.
Fading
Ionosphere
Fading
Besides electrical interference, AM broadcasts are
also susceptible to other types of interference, especially at night. This is because AM radio waves
bounce off the ionosphere at night. These radio
waves then interfere with the signals from the same
transmitter that reach the vehicle’s antenna directly.
This type of interference is called ”fading”.
BE2819
Author:
Date:
2306
BE–87
BODY ELECTRICAL
Multipath
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Multipath
One type of interference caused by bouncing of radio waves off obstructions is called ”multipath”. Multipath occurs when a signal from the broadcast
transmitter antenna bounces off buildings and
mountains and interferes with the signal that is received directly.
Fade Out
Because FM radio waves are of higher frequencies
than AM radio waves, they bounce off buildings,
mountains, and other obstructions. For this reason,
FM signals often seem to gradually disappear or
fade away as the vehicle goes behind a building or
other obstructions. This is called ”fade out”.
BE2820
Fade Out
BE2821
4.
NOISE PROBLEMS
(a) Questionnaire for noise:
It is very important for noise troubleshooting to have good understanding of the claims from the customers, so that make the
best use of following quenstionnaire and diagnose the problem
accurately.
AM
FM
Noise occurs at a specific place.
Strong possibility of foreign noise.
Noise occurs when listening to
faint broadcasting.
There is a case that the same program is broadcasted
from each local station and that may be the case you are
listening to different station if the program is the same.
Noise occurs only at night.
Strong possibility of the beat from a distant broadcasting.
Noise occurs while driving and
at a specific place.
Strong possibility of multipath noise and fading noise
caused by the changes of FM waves.
HINT:
In the case that the noise occurrence condition does not meet
any of the above quenstionnaire, check based on the ”Trouble
Phenomenon”.
Refer to previous page for multipath and fading.
Author:
Date:
2307
BE–88
BODY ELECTRICAL
Noise
Glass Printed Antenna
Noise
Matlers that require attention when checking:
Noise coming into the radio usually has no harm for
practical use as the noise protection is taken and it
is hardly thinkable for an extremely loud noise to
come in. When extremely loud noise comes into the
radio, check if the grounding is normal where the
antenna is installed.
Check if all the regular noise prevention parts are
properly installed and if there is any installation of
non–authorized parts and non–authorized wiring.
If you leave the radio out of tune (not tuning), it is
easy to diagnose the phenomenon as noise occurs
frequently.
(c)
Antenna and noise:
Electronic signal received by the antenna will reach to the
radio transmitting through the core wire of the coaxial
cable. Any noise wave other than radio wave is mixed into
this core wire, that naturally causes noise in the radio and
poor sound quality. In order to prevent these noises from
mixing into the radio, the core wire inside the coaxial cable
is covered with a mesh wire called shield wire. This shield
wire shelters the noise and transmits it to the ground, thus
preventing noise from mixing in. If this shield wire has
grounding failure, that causes noise.
(d)
Choke coil and noise:
The choke coil is connected in the rear window defogger
circuit. This is conneted so to prevent noise from mixing
into the radio by making the noise current included in the
power source of the rear window defogger flow to the
ground.
Signal
Radio
Noise
N21545
to Radio
Battery
Choke Coil
AUDIO SYSTEM
(b)
Noise
Noise
–
Noise
N21546
Author:
Date:
2308
BE–89
BODY ELECTRICAL
Plug (Main)
Antenna
Terminal
(Main)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Plug (Sub)
Antenna
Terminal
(Sub)
I00399
5.
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Glass printed antenna:
GROUNDING FOR THE ANTENNA CORD AND CHOKE
COIL
HINT:
During troubleshooting, in case that the antenna code continuity check, grounding check and grounding check of the choke
coil are needed, please check refering to the following illustration.
Terminal connection
Normal condition
(1) ↔ (2)
Continuity
(3) ↔ (4)
Continuity
Ground point:
Antenna Cord
Center Brace
Pillar (RH)
Choke Coil
N21548 I00402
I00403
Pillar (LH)
I00407
Author:
Date:
2309
BE–90
BODY ELECTRICAL
6.
Antenna
Terminal
Plug
(1)
(2)
I00400
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Fixed mast antenna:
GROUNDING FOR THE ANTENNA CORD AND CHOKE
COIL
HINT:
During troubleshooting, in case that the antenna code continuity check, grounding check and grounding check of the choke
coil are needed, please check refering to the following illustrations.
Terminal connection
Normal condition
(1) ↔ (2)
Continuity
Ground point:
Antenna Cord
Center Brace
Luggage Room (RH side)
Noise Filter
I00427 I00428
I00429
Pillar (LH)
I00408
Author:
Date:
2310
BE–91
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE0AY–05
TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTICE:
When replacing the internal mechanism (computer part) of the audio system, be careful that no part
of your body or clothing comes in contact with the terminals of the leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
HINT:
This inspection procedure is a simple troubleshooting which should be carried out on the vehicle during system operation and was prepared on the assumption of system component troubles (except for the wires and
connectors, etc.).
Always inspect the trouble taking the following items into consideration.
Open or short circuit of the wire harness
Connector or terminal connection fault
Problem
Radio
Tape Player
CD Player
Noise
No.
Radio not operating when power switch turned ’ON’.
1
Display indicates when power switch turned ’ON’, but no sound (including ’noise’)
is produced.
2
Noise present, but AM – FM not operating.
3
Any speaker does not work.
4
Either AM or FM does not work, reception poor (volume faint), Fewer station presets.
5
Poor reception.
6
Sound quality poor.
7
Preset memory disappears.
8
Cassette tape cannot be inserted.
9
Cassette tape is inserted, but no power.
10
Power coming in, but tape player not operating.
11
Either speaker does not work.
12
Sound quality poor. (volume faint)
13
Tape jammed, malfunction with tape speed or auto–reverse.
14
Cassette tape will not be ejected.
15
CD cannot be inserted.
16
CD inserted, but no power.
17
Power coming in, but CD player not operating.
18
Sound jumps.
19
Sound quality poor (Volume faint).
20
Either speaker does not work.
21
CD will not be ejected.
22
Noise occurs.
23
Noise produced by vibration or shock while driving.
24
Noise produced when engine starts.
25
The term ”AM” includes LW, MW and SW, and the term ”FM” includes UKW.
Author:
Date:
2311
BE–92
BODY ELECTRICAL
1
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
RADIO NOT OPERATING WHEN POWER SWITCH TURNED ’ON’
Radio–CD Plater Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Plater Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does tape or CD player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
NG
Replace fuse.
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
OK
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Is ACC applied to radio?
Yes
NG
Replace fuse.
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
OK
No
Is +B applied to radio?
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio is OK?
+B wire harness faulty.
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
Author:
Date:
2312
BE–93
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Does tape or CD player operate normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
No
NG
Replace fuse.
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
OK
Is ACC applied to power amplifier?
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier or wire harness faulty.
Yes
No
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier or wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
I03349
Author:
Date:
2313
BE–94
BODY ELECTRICAL
2
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
DISPLAY INDICATES WHEN POWER SWITCH TURNED
’ON’, BUT NO SOUND (INCLUDING ’NOISE’) IS PRODUCED
Radio
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does tape or CD player operate normally?
Yes
Radio faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC applied to radio?
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to radio?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio faulty.
I03350
Author:
Date:
2314
BE–95
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does tape player operate normally?
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC applied to power amplifier.
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier.
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
No
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Speaker faulty.
No
No
Hiss noise from speaker?
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty. Recheck system after repair.
V08239
Author:
Date:
2315
BE–96
BODY ELECTRICAL
3
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
NOISE PRESENT, BUT AM–FM NOT OPERATING
Yes
Does tape player operate normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Yes
Separate amplifier?
No
Hiss noise from speaker?
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
No
Radio assembly faulty.
4
Radio
ANY SPEAKER DOSE NOT WORK
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does tape or CD player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is hiss noise produced by non–functioning speaker?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does tape player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is hiss noise produced by non–functioning speaker?
Yes
Radio assembly
Recheck system after repair.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
No
Yes
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Speaker faulty.
No
Power amplifier faulty. Recheck system after repair.
I03351
Author:
Date:
2316
BE–97
BODY ELECTRICAL
5
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
EITHER AM OR FM DOES NOT WORK, RECEPTION
POOR (VOLUME FAINT), FEWER STATION PRESETS
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Problem with radio wave signals or location?
Yes
Poor signals, poor location.
No
Are both AM or FM defective?
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Is power for the antenna being output from the radio assembly?
No
Yes
Go to No.15
Does tape player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Problem with radio wave signals or location?
Yes
Poor signals, poor location.
No
Are both AM and FM defective?
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Is power for the antenna being output from the radio assembly?
No
Yes
Go to No.15
Does tape player operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Hiss noise from speaker?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty. Recheck system after repair.
V08242
I03352
Author:
Date:
2317
BE–98
BODY ELECTRICAL
6
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
POOR RECEPTION
Is the condition bad in comparison with other vehicle?
Yes
An electric wave environment.
No
Yes
Is there any additional installation parts? (Sun shade film,
telephone antenna etc.).
Does the condition get better if removing them?
Yes
No
No
Check if there is any scratch and breaking in a
wire on the glass antenna and the defogger pattern.
(See page BE–115)
Influence of additional installation parts.
Yes
Repair
No
Is the contact of the plug jack of the radio OK?
No
Check for contact.
Yes
No
Does the condition get better by using the outer
antenna? (Such as pillar antenna)
Check the radio.
Yes
No
Is the contact of the antenna terminal on the glass
surface and the defogger terminal?
Measure for contact.
Yes
No
Is the continuity of the antenna cord OK?
Exchange the antenna cord.
Yes
NG
Check the grounding of the antenna, antenna cord,
choke coil and noise filter.
Grounding failure.
OK
Yes
Does the condition get better by exchanging the choke
coil?
Exchange the choke coil.
No
Yes
Does the condition get better by exchanging the
antenna cord?
Exchange the antenna cord.
No
Exchange the glass.
I01472
Author:
Date:
2318
BE–99
BODY ELECTRICAL
7
Radio
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
SOUND QUALITY POOR
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
No
Is sound quality always bad?
Yes
Is sound quality bad in
certain area only.
Poor signals,
poor location.
No
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Does tape player operate normally?
Radio assembly
faulty.
No
No
Installed properly.
Is speaker properly installed?
Yes
Yes
Speaker faulty.
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power amplifier)
Radio–Tape CD Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Is sound quality always bad?
No
Yes
Is sound quality bad only in
certain areas?
Poor signals, poor
location.
No
Yes
Does tape player operate normally?
Yes
No
Radio assembly or power
amplifier faulty.
Does tape player operate normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installe properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker. Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly or power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
I03353
Author:
Date:
2319
BE–100
BODY ELECTRICAL
8
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
PRESET MEMORY DISAPPEARS
Radio
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Can cassette tape be inserted in tape player?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Replace fuse.
NG
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Can cassette tape be inserted in tape player?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly?
NG
Power amplifier faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
I03354
Author:
Date:
2320
BE–101
BODY ELECTRICAL
9
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CASSETTE TAPE CANNOT BE INSERTED
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Is there a foreign object inside tape player?
Yes
Remove foreign object.
No
Does auto search button of radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Is there a foreign object inside tape player?
Yes
Remove foreign object.
No
Yes
Does auto search button radio operate normally?
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to power amplifier is OK?
NG
GND faulty.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
NG
Power amplifier faulty.
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
V08246
Author:
Date:
2321
BE–102
BODY ELECTRICAL
10
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CASSETTE TAPE IS INSERTED, BUT NO POWER
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normal?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.2 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC applied to power amplifier?
No
ACC wire harness faulty.
Yes
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is ACC applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
V08247
Author:
Date:
2322
BE–103
BODY ELECTRICAL
11
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
POWER COMING IN, BUT TAPE PLAYER NOT OPERATING
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Functions OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Function OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Hissing sound from speaker?
Yes
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
V08248
Author:
Date:
2323
BE–104
BODY ELECTRICAL
12
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
EITHER SPEAKER DOES NOT WORK
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is hiss noise produces by non–functioning speaker.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is hiss noise produced by non–functioning speaker.
Yes
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly or power amplifier faulty.
V08249
Author:
Date:
2324
BE–105
BODY ELECTRICAL
13
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
SOUND QUALITY POOR (VOLUME FAINT)
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Functions OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Yes
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Head dirty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Functions OK if different cassette tape inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Yes
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Head dirty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly faulty or power amplifier faulty.
V08250
Author:
Date:
2325
BE–106
BODY ELECTRICAL
14
Tape Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
TAPE JAMMED, MALFUNCTION WITH TAPE SPEED OR AUTO–REVERSE
Function OK if different tape (less than 120 mints.) inserted?
Yes
Cassette tape faulty.
No
Yes
Is there a foreign object inside tape player?
Remove foreign object.
No
Operates normally after cleaning the heads?
Yes
Head dirty.
No
Radio assembly faulty.
15
Tape Player
CASSETTE TAPE WILL NOT BE EJECTED
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
No
Does tape player operate normally?
Cassette tape jammed.
Yes
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
NG
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
Radio–Tape Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does tape player operate normally?
No
Cassette tape jammed.
Yes
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is +B applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
V08251
Author:
Date:
2326
BE–107
BODY ELECTRICAL
16
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
CD CANNOT BE INSERTED
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Is CD already inserted?
Eject CD.
No
Yes
Is auto search button of radio operating normally?
No
Is +B applied to CD player?
Radio assembly
faulty.
Yes
NG
Check that GND wire harness side
to CD player is OK?
No
OK
CD player faulty.
NG
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
Replace fuse.
OK
No
Is +B applied to power amplifier?
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
NG
Check that GND (wire harness side) to radio assembly is OK?
OK
Radio assembly faulty.
17
CD Player
CD INSERTED, BUT NO POWER
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
Is ACC applied to CD player?
No
Radio assembly
faulty.
Yes
No
Check that RAD No.1 and No.2 fuse is OK?
CD player faulty.
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is ACC and +B, +B2 applied to power amplifier?
No
ACC and +B, +B2 wire harness faulty.
I03355
Yes
Is ACC and +B, +B2 applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
I03355
Author:
Date:
2327
BE–108
BODY ELECTRICAL
18
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
POWER COMING IN, BUT CD PLAYER NOT OPERATING
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
No
Is CD inserted with correct side up?
Insert correctly.
Yes
Yes
Function OK if different CD inserted?
CD faulty.
No
Yes
Does radio operate normally?
Is temperature inside cabin hot?
Protective circuit in
operation.
No
No
Has sudden temperature change
occurred inside cabin?
Yes
Yes
Formation of condensation
due to temp. changes.
No
CD player faulty.
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
No
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Hissing sound from speaker?
Yes
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
I03356
Author:
Date:
2328
BE–109
BODY ELECTRICAL
19
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
SOUND JUMPS
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Does sound jump only during strong vibration?
Jumping caused by vibration.
No
Is CD player properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
Functions OK if different CD inserted?
Yes
CD faulty.
No
Has sudden temperature change occurred inside cabin?
Yes
No
Formation of condensation due to
temp. changes.
CD player faulty.
20
CD Player
SOUND QUALITY POOR (VOLUME FAINT)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Functions OK if different CD inserted?
CD faulty.
No
Does radio operate normally?
Yes
CD player faulty.
No
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Functions OK?
Yes
Speaker faulty.
No
Radio assembly or CD player or Power amplifier faulty.
I03357
Author:
Date:
2329
BE–110
BODY ELECTRICAL
21
CD Player
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
EITHER SPEAKER DOES NOT WORK
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Yes
Does radio operate normally?
CD player.
No
Yes
Is hiss noise produced by non–functioning speaker?
Radio assembly faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
No
No
Does continuity exist in speaker wire harness?
Speaker wire harness faulty.
Yes
Yes
Temporarily install another speaker.
Function OK.
Speaker faulty.
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Recheck system after repair.
22
CD Player
CD WILL NOT BE EJECTED
Radio–CD Player Unit (Built–in Power Amplifier)
Radio–CD Player Unit (Separate Power Amplifier)
Radio–Tape Player – CD Player (Separate Power Amplifier)
Is auto search button of radio
operating normally?
Yes
Is +B applied to CD player?
No
Radio assembly
faulty.
Yes
No
Check that RAD No.1 fuse is OK?
CD player faulty.
NG
Replace fuse.
OK
Is +B and +B2 applied to power amplifier?
No
+B wire harness faulty.
Yes
Is +B and +B2 applied to radio assembly?
No
Power amplifier faulty.
Yes
Radio assembly faulty.
I03358
Author:
Date:
2330
BE–111
BODY ELECTRICAL
23
Noise
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
NOISE OCCURS
No
Does the noise occur only in the radio?
It occurs in the cassette CD. (Go to step 13 or 20)
Yes
Yes
Does the noise occur in a particular place?
An electric environment.
No
Yes
Is there any additional installation part around the glass
printed antenna? (Sunshade film, telephone antenna, etc.)
Does the noise stop by removing it?
Yes
No
No
Influence of the film of the noise radiation of
additional installation part.
Does the noise occur even pulling out the antenna cord
from the radio?
Yes
Check the radio.
No
Yes
Does the noise occur even pulling out the antenna
terminal on the glass surface?
Mixing into the antenna cable.
No
Yes
Is there any adhesive stuck on the bases of the
antenna terminal, defogger terminal and bus bar?
Failure of glass installation. Must plane the butyl rubber.
No
Yes
Does the noise occur even pulling out the defogger
terminal?
Interfering noise from the defogger line and choke
coil. Does the condition get better by exchanging the
choke coil?
No
Exchange the choke coil.
Check the grounding of the antenna, antenna cord,
choke coil and noise filter.
NG
OK
Grounding failure.
Yes
Does the condition get better by exchanging the antenna
cord?
Exchange the antenna cord.
No
Radiates directly to the antenna from the generation
source.
I01473
Author:
Date:
2331
BE–112
BODY ELECTRICAL
24
Noise
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
NOISE PRODUCED BY VIBRATION OR SHOCK WHILE DRIVING
Is speaker properly installed?
No
Installed properly.
Yes
No
Is speaker properly installed?
Yes
With vehicle stationary lightly tap each system.
Is noise produced?
Yes
Each system faulty.
No
Noise produced by static electricity accumulated in the vehicle body.
I01474
Author:
Date:
2332
BE–113
BODY ELECTRICAL
25
Noise
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
NOISE PRODUCED WHEN ENGINE STARTS
Whistling noise which becomes high–pitched when
accelerator strongly depressed, disappears shortly
after engine stops.
Yes
Generator noise.
No
Whining noise occurs when A/C is operating.
Yes
A/C noise.
No
Scratching noise occurs during sudden acceleration,
driving on rough roads or when ignition switch is turned
on.
Yes
Fuel gauge noise.
No
Clicking sound heard when horn button is pressed,
then released. Whirring/ grating sound when pressed
continuously.
Yes
Horn noise.
No
Murmuring sound stops when engine stops.
Yes
Ignition noise.
No
Tick–tock noise occurs in co–ordination with
blinking of flasher.
Yes
Turn signal noise.
No
Noise occurs during window washer operation.
Yes
Washer noise.
No
Yes
Scratching noise occurs while engine is running
and continues for a while even after engine stops.
Engine coolant temp. gauge noise.
No
Scraping noise in time with wiper beat.
Yes
Wiper noise.
No
Other type of noise.
I01475
Author:
Date:
2333
BE–114
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE0AZ–05
LOCATION
Tweeter Speaker
Tweeter Speaker
AMP
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
RADIO Fuse
DOME Fuse
Glass Printed
Antenna (MAIN)
Front Speaker
Diversity Only
(SUB)
Rear Speaker
Z19489
Author:
Date:
2334
BE–115
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
BE0B0–06
INSPECTION
1.
GLASS PRINTED ANTENNA INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When cleaning the glass, use soft dry cloth, and wipe
the glass in the direction of the wire.
Take care not to damage the wires.
Do not use detergents or glass cleaners with abrasive
ingredients.
NOTICE:
In order not to damage the glass printed antenna, wrap up
the tip of the tester stick with aluminum foil as shown in the
illustration and check by holding the aluminum foil with a
finger.
Tester Probe
Aluminum Foil
BE4029
By placing and moving the tester stick along the glass printed
antenna, check if continuity exists.
I00430
HINT:
Matching module is built in the bus bar of the glass printed antenna (main terminal side) of CAMRY and no continuity exists
between the terminal and the antenna. Therefore, for the continuity checking of the glass printed antenna on the main antenna side of CAMRY, place one probe of the tester on the position
beside the bus bar (position shown in the illustration) and check
by making the other probe of the tester move along.
Matching
module
I00459
2.
(a)
Repair Point
(b)
Broken
Wire
(c)
GLASS PRINTED ANTENNA REPAIR PROCEDURE
Clean the broken wire tips with grease, wax and silicone
remover.
Place the masking tape along both sides of the wire for
repair.
Thoroughly mix the repair agent (Dupont paste No.
4817).
Masking Tape
BE0150
Author:
Date:
2335
BE–116
BODY ELECTRICAL
(d)
(e)
–
AUDIO SYSTEM
Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount of the agent
to the wire.
After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
BE0151
Author:
Date:
2336
BE–117
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
CLOCK
CLOCK
BE0B1–02
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Troubleshoot the clock according to the table below.
Clock will not operate
1
Clock loses or gains time
2
± 1.5 seconds / day
Ground
E
Connector
(Clock Side)
Power Source
(Illumination)
ILL
B
Power Source
(System Operation)
ACC
Power Source
(Display Operation)
4 3 2 1
(Wire Harness Side)
1 2 3 4
Z04388
BE1847 e–4–2–D e–4–1–D
1
CLOCK WILL NOT OPERATE
(a) Check that the battery positive voltage is 10 – 16 V.
(Wire Harness Side)
(Clock Side)
If voltage is not as specified, replace the battery.
(b) Check that the DOME fuse is not blown.
If the fuse is blown, replace the fuse and check for short circuit.
(c) Troubleshoot the clock as follows.
HINT: Inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
B+
GND
e–4–2–D e–4–1–D
Is there battery positive voltage between terminal
B+ and body ground?
No
Open or short circuit in wire harness between
terminal GND and body ground.
No
Open circuit in wire harness between terminal
GND and body ground.
Yes
Does continuity exist between terminal GND
and body ground.
Yes
Replace clock.
V04421
Author:
Date:
2337
BE–118
BODY ELECTRICAL
2
–
CLOCK
CLOCK LOSES OR GAINS TIME
(Clock Side)
(a) Check that the battery positive voltage is 10 – 16 V.
If voltage is not as specified, replace the battery.
(b) Inspect the error of the clock.
Allowable error (per day): ± 1.5 seconds
(Wire Harness Side)
If the error exceeds the allowable error, replace the clock.
(c) Check that the clock adjusting button is caught in position,
and does not return.
If the button is not returned, repair or replace the clock.
(d) Troubleshoot the clock as follows.
HINT: Inspect the connector on the wire harness side.
e–4–2–D
e–4–1–D
B+
GND
Is there 10 – 16 V between terminal B+ and
body ground?
Below 10 V
Locate cause and repair, or recharge battery.
Yes
Adjust or replace clock.
V04422
Author:
Date:
2338
BE–119
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
BE0B2–06
REGISTRATION PROCEDURE
1.
KEY REGISTRATION IN AUTOMATIC REGISTRATION MODE
(a) Registration of a new transponder key.
HINT:
This must be done when you have installed a new ECM.
The new ECM is in the automatic key code registration mode. The already fixed number of key codes
for this ECM can be registered.
On this type of vehicle, up to 4 key codes can be registered.
In the automatic registration mode, the last key registered becomes sub–key.
START
Security indicator blinks until the first
key is inserted. The indicator lights up
after the key registration.
Insert the key in the key cylinder.
Security Indicator ON
Under registration
Security
OFF
Indicator
Registration completion
Remove the key.
Yes
Security Indicator ON
(After the last key (sub–key)
has been registered, the indicator goes off.)
Will you register the
next key?
No
END
Author:
Date:
2339
BE–120
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
HINT:
When a key is not inserted in the key cylinder in the automatic registration mode, the security indicator
always lights on.
When the immobiliser system operations normally and the key is pull out, the security indicator blinks.
When key code registration could not be performed in the automatic registration mode, code 2–1 is
output from the security indicator and when inserting the already registered key, code 2–2 is output.
Blinks
1.2 Sec.
0.8 Sec.
(b)
Code 2–1
0.25 Sec.
1 Sec.
0.25 Sec. 0.5 Sec.
Code2–2
0.25 Sec.
1 Sec.
0.25 Sec.0.5 Sec.
Automatic registration mode completion
If completing the mode forcibly when more than 1 key code have been registered in the automatic registration mode, perform the following procedures.
After 1 more key code have been registered with master key, perform step (1) or (2) without pulling
the key out or inserting the already registered key.
(1) Depress and release brake pedal 5 times or more within 15sec.
(2) With the TOYOTA hand–held tester, require automatic registration mode completion.
Author:
Date:
2340
BE–121
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
2.
REGISTRATION OF ADDITIONAL MASTER KEY
There are 2 ways for registration of additional master key, one is depressing brake pedal and acceleration
pedal and the other is using TOYOTA hand–held tester.
HINT:
It is possible to register up to 7 master key codes including the already registered key code.
When any operation time described below is over, registration mode completes.
When the next procedure is performed while the timer is working, the timer completes counting time,
then next timer starts.
(1) Depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal:
Insert already registered master key in the key
cylinder
Depress and release the acceleration pedal 5
times.
Depress and release the brake pedal 6 times,
and remove the master key.
Within 15 sec.
Within 20 sec.
Within 10 sec.
Insert key to be registered in key cylinder.
Depress and release the acceleration pedal 1
time. (Security indicator blinks)
Within 10 sec.
Within 10 sec.
After 60 sec. additional master key is registered.
(Security indicator is OFF)
Yes
Will you register the
next key?
No
The registration mode completes when pulling
out the key within 10sec. and the brake pedal is
depressed or after indicator is off 10 sec. pass.
Author:
Date:
2341
BE–122
BODY ELECTRICAL
(2)
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
Insert already registered master key in the key cylinder.
Within 120 sec.
Listing TOYOTA hand–held tester select master key registration.
Within 20 sec.
Remove the master key.
Within 10 sec.
Insert key to be registered in key cylinder.
(Security indicator blinks)
Within
10 sec.
Within 10 sec.
After 60 sec., additional master key is registered.
(Security indicator OFF)
Yes
Will you register the
next key?
No
The registration mode completes when pulling out the key
within 10sec. and the brake pedal is depressed or after indicator is off 10 sec. pass.
Author:
Date:
2342
BE–123
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
3.
REGISTRATION ADDITIONAL OF SUB–KEY
There are 2 ways for registration of additional sub–key, one is depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal and the other is using TOYOTA hand–held tester.
HINT:
It is possible top register up to 3 sub–key codes including the already registered key code.
When any operation time described below is over, registration mode completes.
When the next procedure is performed while the timer is working, the timer completes counting time,
then next timer starts.
(1) Depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal:
Insert already registered master key in the key
cylinder
Depress and release the acceleration pedal 4
times.
Depress and release the brake pedal 5 times,
and remove the master key.
Within 15 sec.
Within 20 sec.
Within 10 sec.
Insert key to be registered in key cylinder.
Within 10 sec.
Depress and release the acceleration pedal 1
time. (Security indicator blinks)
Within 10 sec.
After 60 sec. additional sub–key is registered.
(Security indicator is OFF)
Yes
Will you register the
next key?
No
The registration mode completes when pulling
out the key within 10sec. and the brake pedal is
depressed or after indicator is off 10 sec. pass.
Author:
Date:
2343
BE–124
BODY ELECTRICAL
(2)
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
Insert already registered master key in the key cylinder.
Within 120 sec.
Listing TOYOTA hand–held tester select sub–key registration.
Within 20 sec.
Remove the master key.
Within 10 sec.
Insert key to be registered in key cylinder.
(Security indicator blinks)
Within
10 sec.
Within 10 sec.
After 60 sec., additional master key is registered.
(Security indicator OFF)
Yes
Will you register the
next key?
No
The registration mode completes when pulling out the key
within 10sec. and the brake pedal is depressed or after indicator is off 10 sec. pass.
Author:
Date:
2344
BE–125
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
4.
ERASURE OF TRANSPONDER KEY CODE
There are 2 ways for erasure of transponder key code, one is depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal
and the other is using TOYOTA hand–held tester.
NOTICE:
All other master and sub–key codes are deleted leaving the master key code to use the operation.
When using the key which was used before deleting, it is necessary to register the code again.
HINT:
When any operation time described below is over, registration mode completes.
When the next procedure is performed while the timer is working, the timer completes counting time,
then next timer starts.
(1) Depressing brake pedal and acceleration pedal:
1. Insert master key in the key cylinder.
Within 15 sec.
2. Depress and release the acceleration pedal 6 times.
Within 20 sec.
3. Depress and release the brake pedal 7 times.
(Security indicator blinks)
Within 10 sec.
4. Remove the master key.
(Security indicator blinks)
END
(Key code erasured)
HINT:
When the key cannot be pulled out in the step 4, key code deletion is canceled.
(Security indicator is OFF)
Author:
Date:
2345
BE–126
BODY ELECTRICAL
(2)
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
Using TOYOTA hand–held tester:
1. Insert master key in the key cylinder.
Within 120 sec.
2. Require key code deletion from hand–held tester.
(Security indicator blinks)
Within 10 sec.
3. Remove the master key.
END
(Key code erasured)
HINT:
When the key cannot be pulled out in the step 3, key code deletion is canceled.
(Security indicator is OFF)
Author:
Date:
2346
BE–127
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
BE0B3–06
LOCATION
Engine Room J/B No.2
EFI Fuse
Transponder Key Amplifier
Transponder Key Coil
ECM
Instrument Panel J/B
IGN Fuse
I02682
Author:
Date:
2347
BE–128
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
BE0B4–05
INSPECTION
INSPECTION TRANSPONDER KEY COIL CONTINUITY
Check that continuity exists between terminal 1 and 2.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the coil.
I03099
Author:
Date:
2348
BO–1
BODY
–
CLIP
CLIP
REPLACEMENT
BO0LJ–01
The removal and installation methods of typical clips used in body parts are shown in the table below.
HINT:
If the clip is damaged during the operation, always replace it with a new clip.
Shape (Example)
Removal/Installation
Pliers
Clip Remover
Screwdriver
Scraper
V00005
Author:
Date:
2349
BO–2
BODY
Shape (Example)
–
CLIP
Removal/Installation
Removal
Removal
Installation
Installation
V00012
Author:
Date:
2350
BO–3
BODY
–
SRS AIRBAG
SRS AIRBAG
BO0KU–01
PRECAUTION
The CAMRY is equipped with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the driver airbag, front passenger airbag, side airbag and seat belt pretensioner. Failure to carry out service operation in the correct sequence could cause the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read
the precautionary notices in the RS section.
Author:
Date:
2351
BO–4
BODY
–
FRONT BUMPER
FRONT BUMPER
BO0KV–01
COMPONENTS
Turn Signal Light Assembly
Clip
Turn Signal Light Assembly
Upper Reinforcement
Sub–Assembly
Fender Liner
No.2
Reinforcement
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
34 (350, 25)
Front Bumper
Reinforcement
Emblem,
Radiator Grill
34 (350, 25)
Clip
Fender Liner
Energy Absorber
Mounting Plate
Front Bumper
Energy Absorber
Bumper Cover
Engine Under Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
H01708
Author:
Date:
2352
BO–5
BODY
–
FRONT BUMPER
BO0KW–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
(a) Engine under cover
(b) Fender liner
(c) Turn signal light assembly
HINT:
Remove the light assembly as shown.
H01709
2.
(a)
REMOVE BUMPER COVER
Remove the 2 bolts and 3 clips.
Torque: 5.5 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
(b)
(c)
Remove the bolt holding the bumper end to the fender.
Pull the bumper cover forward to remove the bumper cover from the clip under the turn signal light area.
Pull the bumper cover forward to remove it.
H01710
(d)
H01711
H01712
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the refer to the following item.
Align the holes of the bumper cover with the 2 bumper stays of
the reinforcement.
3.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
(a) Front bumper energy absorber
(b) Front bumper reinforcement
Torque: 34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
(c) Front bumper upper reinforcement subassembly
Author:
Date:
2353
BO–6
BODY
–
FRONT BUMPER
BO0KX–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–5).
Author:
Date:
2354
BO–7
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
BO0KY–01
COMPONENTS
Left Side Luggage Trim
Right Side Luggage Trim
Rear Bumper Reinforcement
Rear Bumper Energy Absorber
34 (350, 25)
Rear Bumper
Side Retainer
5.0 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
5.0 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Quarter Air Duct
Rear Bumper
Side Retainer
Rear Bumper Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified Torque
H01713
Author:
Date:
2355
BO–8
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
BO0KZ–01
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
Right side luggage trim
Left side luggage trim
REMOVE REAR BUMPER COVER
Remove the 7 clips, 2 bolts and 6 nuts from the bumper
cover.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 43 in.·lbf)
H01714
H01715
(b) Pull the bumper cover rearward to remove it.
HINT:
With a plastic hammer, tap the ends of the bumper end bolts.
(c) Using a screwdriver, slide the rear bumper side retainers
from the bumper ends.
(d) Remove the 2 gaskets from the side retainers.
HINT:
Use 2 new gaskets.
3.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
(a) Rear bumper energy absorber
(b) Rear bumper reinforcement
Torque: 34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2356
BO–9
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
BO0L0–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–8).
Author:
Date:
2357
BO–10
BODY
–
HOOD
HOOD
BO0L1–01
ADJUSTMENT
Centering Bolt
Bolt with Washer
HINT:
Since the centering bolt is used as the hood hinge and lock set
bolt, the hood and lock can not be adjusted with it on. Substitute
a bolt and washer for the centering bolt.
BO5235
1.
ADJUST HOOD IN FORWARD/REARWARD AND
LEFT/RIGHT DIRECTIONS
Adjust the hood by loosening the hood side hinge bolts.
Torque: 26 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
N20963
2.
ADJUST FRONT EDGE OF HOOD IN VERTICAL
DIRECTIONS
Adjust the hood by turning the cushions.
N20964
3.
(a)
N20965
ADJUST HOOD LOCK
Replace each centering bolt with a regular bolt and washer.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 71 in.·lbf)
HINT:
Remove the anti–theft bolt cover, then remove the lower hood
lock bolt. You may have to remove the front bumper to access
this bolt.
(b) Adjust the lock by loosening the bolts.
Author:
Date:
2358
BO–11
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR
BO0L2–01
COMPONENTS
Front Door Upper Moulding
Outside
Rear View
Mirror
Front Door Belt Moulding
Door Lock
Cylinder
Outside Handle
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Door Glass
Door Frame
5.0 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Door Glass
Run
Door Lock
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Service Hole Cover
8.0 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
Door Hinge
31 (310, 22)
23 (230, 17)
26 (260, 19)
Door Lock Striker
Window Regulator
8.0 (80, 71 in.·lbf)
30 (300, 22)
X6
7.5 (75, 66 in.·lbf)
Door
Check
Regulator
Motor
X3
31 (310, 22)
Door Hinge
Speaker
26 (260, 19)
Rear Lower
Frame
Front Lower
Frame
Front Window Upper
Garnish
Power Window Switch
Inside Handle
3.5 (35, 31 in.·lbf)
Inside Handle Bezel
Door Trim
Driver’s Side:
Regulator
Motor
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
P
t d
H01975
t
Author:
Date:
2359
BO–12
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
BO0L3–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
H01738
w/o Power Window:
REMOVE REGULATOR HANDLE
Pull off the snap ring with a shop rag and remove the regulator
handle and plate.
HINT:
At the time of assembly, please refer to the following item.
With the door window fully closed, install the plate and the regulator handle with the snap ring.
2.
(a)
N20968
4 Clips
N21003
REMOVE INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL
Using a screwdriver, pry open the screw cover and remove the screw.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the bezel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE FRONT WINDOW UPPER GARNISH
4.
REMOVE DOOR TRIM
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the screw caps.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 clips, 2 screws and 2 bolts.
(c)
Insert a screwdriver between the door and door trim to pry
out.
(d) Pull the trim upward to remove it, then remove the power
window switch and disconnect the harness connector.
5.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
(a) Outside rear view mirror
Torque: 5.5 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
(b) Speaker
6.
(a)
REMOVE DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
Remove the screw and pull the handle forward.
Torque: 3.5 N·m (35 kgf·cm, 31 in.·lbf)
(b) Remove the link from the clamp.
(c) Remove the inside handle from the ends of the 2 links.
7.
REMOVE SERVICE HOLE COVER
Remove the grommet, then remove the service hole cover.
(c)
(a)
(b)
N20969
Author:
Date:
2360
BO–13
BODY
8.
(a)
(a)
(b)
(b)
N20970
–
FRONT DOOR
REMOVE DOOR GLASS
Open the door glass until the bolt appears in the service
hole.
Remove the 2 bolts and the door glass.
(b)
HINT:
Pull the glass upward.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 71 in.·lbf)
9.
REMOVE GLASS RUN
HINT:
Pull the glass run upward.
10. REMOVE FRONT AND REAR SIDE FRAMES
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and the side frames.
HINT:
Remove the side frames through the service hole.
11. REMOVE FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
Pry the rearward end of the front door belt moulding from the
door and remove the moulding.
Clip
N21004
12. REMOVE FRONT DOOR UPPER MOULDING
(a) Using a drill, cut the flange portion of the 7 rivets.
HINT:
At the time of assembly, please refer to the following item.
Use 7 new rivets.
(b) Pry out the 2 clips and remove the moulding.
: 7 rivets
: clip
: clip
: clip
H01729
Author:
Date:
2361
BO–14
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
13. REMOVE WINDOW REGULATOR ASSEMBLY
Remove the bolts and window regulator.
Torque: 5.5 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Apply MP grease to the window regulator rollers.
14. w/ Power Window:
REMOVE MOTOR FROM WINDOW REGULATOR
Remove the 3 screws and motor.
w/ Power Window:
w/o Power Window:
H01730
15.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE DOOR LOCK
Remove the 2 clips.
Disconnect the 2 links from the door lock and remove the
links.
Disconnect the 2 links from the outside handle and the
lock cylinder.
Remove the 3 screws and door lock.
N20971
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Apply adhesive to 3 screws.
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 43 in.·lbf)
(e) w/ Power Door Lock:
Disconnect the connector.
(f)
Remove the door lock through the service hole.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Apply MP grease to the sliding surface of the door lock.
16. REMOVE OUTSIDE HANDLE
Torque: 7.0 N·m (70 kgf·cm, 61 in.·lbf)
w/o Power Door Lock
w/ Power Door Lock
H01732
Author:
Date:
2362
BO–15
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
BO0L4–01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
ADJUST DOOR IN FORWARD/REARWARD AND VERTICAL DIRECTIONS
Using SST, adjust the door by loosening the body side hinge
bolts.
SST 09812–00020
Torque: 31 N·m (310 kgf·cm, 22 ft·lbf)
SST
N20966
2.
ADJUST DOOR IN LEFT/RIGHT AND VERTICAL
DIRECTIONS
To adjust, loosen the door side hinge.
HINT:
Substitute the bolt and washer for the centering bolt.
Torque: 26 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
N20967
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
ADJUST DOOR LOCK STRIKER
Check that door fits and the door lock linkages are adjusted correctly.
Loosen the striker mounting screws to adjust.
Using a plastic hammer, tap the striker to adjust it.
Torque: 23 N·m (230 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
BO2556
Author:
Date:
2363
BO–16
BODY
–
FRONT DOOR
BO0L5–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–12).
Author:
Date:
2364
BO–17
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR
BO0L6–01
COMPONENTS
Rear Door Upper
Moulding
w/o Power Door
Lock:
Door Belt Moulding
Door Lock
Door Glass
Outside handle
7.0 (70, 61 in.·lbf)
Door Glass Run
Door Lock
Door Lock Control Link
Child Protector
Lock Lever Cover
5.0 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Door Lock Remote
Control Link
8.0 (80, 71 in.·lbf)
Door Hinge
26 (260, 19)
8.0 (80, 71 in.·lbf)
Door Lock Striker
Door Check
30 (300, 22)
23 (230, 17)
Window
Regulator
Motor
Rear Side Frame
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Window Regulator
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Door Hinge
Cover
Power Window
Switch
Service Hole Cover
Inside Handle
Door Trim
3.5 (35, 31 in.·lbf)
Rear Door Weatherstrip
26 (260, 19)
w/o Power Window:
Plate
Snap Ring
Regulator
Handle
Inside Handle Bezel
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H01733
Author:
Date:
2365
BO–18
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
BO0L8–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
H01738
w/o Power Window:
REMOVE REGULATOR HANDLE
Pull off the snap ring with a shop rag and remove the regulator
handle and plate.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
With the door window fully closed, install the plate and the regulator handle with the snap ring.
2.
w/ Power Window:
REMOVE POWER WINDOW SWITCH
Using a screwdriver, pry out the switch, then disconnect the
connector.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
(a)
N20968
6 Clips
N21007
REMOVE INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL
Using a screwdriver, pry open the screw cover and remove the screw.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the bezel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before using. Use the screwdriver to release the bezel from the top and bottom protrusions on the handle assembly as shown.
4.
REMOVE DOOR TRIM
HINT:
Tape a screwdriver tip before use.
(a) Using the screwdriver, remove the 2 screw caps.
(b) Remove the inside cover.
(c) Remove the 2 screws and clip.
(d) Insert the screwdriver between the door and door trim to
pry out.
(e) Pull the trim upward to remove it, then disconnect the connector.
5.
REMOVE DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
(a) Remove the screw and pull the handle forward.
Torque: 3.5 N·m (35 kgf·cm, 31 in.·lbf)
(b) Remove the link from the clamp.
(c) Remove the inside handle from the ends of the 2 links.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE HOLE COVER
Remove the grommet, then remove the service hole cover.
N20969
Author:
Date:
2366
BO–19
BODY
7.
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(c)
(a)
N20974
–
REAR DOOR
REMOVE DOOR GLASS AND RUN
Remove the bolt and nut holding the rear side frame to the
door.
Remove the 2 bolts holding the door glass to the window
regulator.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 71 in.·lbf)
Remove the rear side frame and the rear section of the
door glass run.
Torque: 5.5 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
HINT:
Pull the door glass run upward.
(d) Remove the door glass.
(e) Remove the entire door glass run.
HINT:
Pull the door glass run upward.
Clip
8.
REMOVE REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
Pry the rearward end of the rear door belt moulding from the
door and remove the moulding.
N21008
: 7 rivets
: clips
: clips
: clips
9.
REMOVE REAR DOOR UPPER MOULDING
(a) Using a drill, cut the flange portion of the 5 rivets.
HINT:
Use 5 new rivets.
(b) Insert a screwdriver between the door and the rear door
upper moulding and pry it off.
H01743
Author:
Date:
2367
BO–20
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
10. REMOVE WINDOW REGULATOR ASSEMBLY
Remove the bolts and window regulator assembly.
Torque: 5.5 N·m (55 kgf·cm,49 in.·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Apply MP grease to the window regulator rollers.
11. w/ Power Window:
REMOVE MOTOR FROM WINDOW REGULATOR
Remove the 3 screws and motor.
w/ Power Window:
w/o Power Window:
12.
H01744
REMOVE REAR DOOR LOCK CHILD PROTECTION
COVER
Using a screwdriver, pry out the cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
13.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(b)
(b)
(a )
N20975
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Apply adhesive to the 3 screws.
Part No. 08833–00070, THREE BOND 1324 or equivalent
(e)
w/o Power Door Lock
REMOVE DOOR LOCK
Remove the clip.
Disconnect the 2 links from the door lock and remove the
2 links.
Disconnect the link from the outside handle.
Remove the 3 screws.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 43 in.·lbf)
w/ Power Door Lock:
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the door lock through the service hole.
(f)
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Apply MP grease to the sliding surface of the door lock.
14. REMOVE OUTSIDE HANDLE
Torque: 7.0 N·m (70 kgf·cm, 61 in.·lbf)
w/ Power Door LockH01746
Author:
Date:
2368
BO–21
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
BO0L7–01
ADJUSTMENT
3 Clips
1.
2 Clips
N21006
ADJUST DOOR IN FORWARD/REARWARD AND VERTICAL DIRECTION
Remove the front part of the rear seat side garnish.
Remove the rear part of the front door inside scuff plate.
Remove the center pillar lower garnish.
(a)
(b)
(c)
HINT:
Pull both sides of the top and bottom part of the garnish outward, then pull out to remove the garnish.
(d) Loosen the body side hinge nuts to adjust.
Torque: 26 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
(e) Install center pillar lower garnish.
(f)
Install front door inside scuff plate.
(g) Install rear seat side garnish.
N20972
2.
ADJUST DOOR IN LEFT/RIGHT AND VERTICAL
DIRECTIONS
Loosen the door side hinge bolts to adjust.
HINT:
Substitute a bolt with washer for the centering bolt.
Torque: 26 N·m (260 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
N20973
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
ADJUST DOOR LOCK STRIKER
Check that the door fit and door lock linkages are adjusted
correctly.
Loosen the striker mounting screws to adjust.
Torque: 23 N·m (230 kgf·cm, 17 ft·lbf)
Using a plastic hammer, tap the striker to adjust it.
BO2556
Author:
Date:
2369
BO–22
BODY
–
REAR DOOR
BO0L9–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–18).
Author:
Date:
2370
BO–23
BODY
–
OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
BO0LA–01
COMPONENTS
Outside Rear View Mirror
Cover
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Door Trim
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified Torque
H01758
Author:
Date:
2371
BO–24
BODY
–
OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
BO0LB–01
DISASSEMBLY
IMI:
1.
(a)
Mirror
Mirror Shell
(b)
Gasket
UTA:
Mirror w/case
Wire Retainer
(c)
(d)
TOKAIRIKA:
Mirror w/case
IDENTIFY OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
w/ Power Rear View Mirror:
UTA:
The mirror moves smoothly when pressing the end of the
mirror inward.
w/ Power Rear View Mirror:
IMI:
The mirror stutters when pressing the end of the mirror inward.
w/ Power Rear View Mirror:
TOKAIRIKA:
Equipped only on vehicles manufactured by TMC.
w/o Power Rear View Mirror:
Mirrors manufactured by IMI
Clip X4
H01759
2.
Gasket
Mirror w/case
Mirror Housing
Wire Retainer
H01760
UTA:
DISASSEMBLE OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) Disconnect the battery.
(b) Press the inboard end of the mirror inward to access the
rear of the mirror w/case assembly.
(c) Unlatch both ends of the wire retainer, then remove the
mirror parts from the mirror housing.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the wires on heated mirrors. Disconnect the wires from the back side of the heater.
3.
IMI:
DISASSEMBLE OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) w/Heated Mirrors:
Disconnect the battery.
(b) Protect the door surface.
(c) Pivot the mirror housing to the forward position.
Pivot Mirror Housing Forward
H01761
(d)
Mirror
Glass
Terminals
Mirror Case
Scraper
Insert a scraper between the mirror and the case to remove the mirror.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the wires on heated mirrors. Disconnect the wires from the back side of the heater.
H01762
Author:
Date:
2372
BO–25
BODY
Shop Towel
Mirror
Housing
H01763
–
OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
4.
TOKAIRIKA:
DISASSEMBLE OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) Disconnect the battery.
(b) Slide a shop towel between the mirror and the mirror
housing as shown.
(c) Pull the ends of the shop towel upward to disconnect the
mirror from the housing.
(d) Pull the mirror upward and disconnect it.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the wires on heated mirrors. Disconnect the wires from the back side of the heater.
Author:
Date:
2373
BO–26
BODY
–
OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
BO0LC–01
Gasket
1.
Mirror w/case
Mirror Housing
REASSEMBLY
Wire Retainer
H01764
UTA:
ASSEMBLE OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) w/Heated Mirrors:
Connect the heater wires.
(b) Install the wire retainer onto the mirror w/case assembly,
then press the mirror firmly into place to engage the 6 lugs
of the wire retainer.
NOTICE:
Pull the mirror edges to confirm the wire retainer lugs completely engage with the mirror housing.
(c) Reconnect the battery, then operate the mirror to its full
stop position.
2.
50–60 mm
H01765
Glass
Case
Edge
Claw B
H01766
Claw A
H01767
IMI:
ASSEMBLE OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) From a distance of 50–60 mm, use a heat gun or hair dryer to heat the edge of the mirror case until the mirror case
becomes soft.
CAUTION:
Use extreme caution when using a heat gun or hair dryer.
Holding it too close can melt the mirror case.
(b) w/ Heated Mirrors:
Connect the heater wires.
(c) Before the the case cools down, position and snap the
new mirror glass into the case.
NOTICE:
Verify the glass case edge completely surrounds the mirror
glass.
(d) Allow the case to cool down before moving the mirror
back to its operating position.
(e) Recheck the fit between the glass and the case.
(f)
Reconnect the battery, then operate the mirror to its full
stop position.
3.
TOKAIRIKA:
ASSEMBLE OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) w/ Heated Mirrors:
Connect the heater wires.
(b) Connect the claws (A) and install the mirror into the mirror
housing.
(c) Push the mirror inward to connect the claws (B) onto the
mirror housing.
(d) Reconnect the battery, then operate the mirror to its full
stop position.
Author:
Date:
2374
BO–27
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO0LD–01
COMPONENTS
Torsion Bar
Luggage Compartment Door Hinge
Luggage Compartment Door Hinge
8.0 (80, 71 in.·lbf)
8.0 (80, 71 in.·lbf)
Luggage Compartment
Door
Luggage Compartment
Door Trim
Right Side Luggage
Trim
Lock Cylinder
Left Side Luggage
Trim
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Right Hand
Back Up Light
Door Lock
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Luggage Compartment Floor Mat
Left Hand Back
Up Light
Door Lock Striker
Package Tray Trim
Finish Side Trim
High Mounted
Stop Light
Rear Seatback
Finish Side Trim
Rear Luggage Trim
Room Partition Trim
Rear Seat Cushion
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H01747
Author:
Date:
2375
BO–28
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO0LE–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
4.
(a)
2
1
1
(b)
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR TRIM
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR
Disconnect the connector.
Using a clip remover, disconnect the clamps.
Remove the 4 bolts and door.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 71 in.·lbf)
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
Luggage compartment floor mat
LH and RH rear floor finish side plates
Inner cover trims
Rear seat
Room partition trims
REMOVE HIGH–MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
Push on the both side of the cover to release the claws by
your hand and remove the cover as shown in the illustration.
Remove the 2 bolts and stop light, then disconnect the
connector.
N22588
5.
REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
(a) Remove the clip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry loose and remove the garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6.
REMOVE PACKAGE TRAY TRIM
: 4 Clips
N21430
7.
(a)
REMOVE TORSION BAR
Remove the torsion bar from the center bracket.
N22591
Author:
Date:
2376
BO–29
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
(b)
Install SST to the torsion bar on the hinge side.
SST 09804–24010
(c)
Push down on SST, and pull the luggage compartment
door hinge from the torsion bar.
(d)
Slowly lift SST, and remove the torsion bar from the torsion bar bracket with SST.
Remove the torsion bar.
Repeat for the other side.
SST
BO4010
SST
BO4011
(e)
(f)
SST
BO4012
Author:
Date:
2377
BO–30
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO0LF–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE DOOR LOCK
Disconnect the control link.
Remove the 2 bolts and lock.
Torque: 5.5 N·m (56 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LIGHT
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 10 nuts and rear combination lights.
Author:
Date:
2378
BO–31
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO0LG–01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N22589
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ADJUST LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR
Remove the 11 clips and luggage compartment door trim.
For forward/rearward and left/right adjustments loosen
the bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N·m (82 kgf·cm, 71 in.·lbf)
For vertical adjustment of the front end of the door, increase or decrease the number of washers between the
hinge and the door.
ADJUST DOOR LOCK STRIKER
Remove the LH and RH rear floor finish side plates.
Remove the rear floor finish plate.
Loosen the 2 lock striker set bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N·m (56 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
Using a hammer and a brass bar, tap the striker to adjust
it.
N22590
Author:
Date:
2379
BO–32
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO0LH–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–30).
Author:
Date:
2380
BO–33
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO0LI–01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL TORSION BAR
(a) Insert the torsion bar into the bracket.
HINT:
The center bracket opening is the nominal position of the torsion bar.
If needed, move the torsion bar to the upper or lower hole to provide the correct luggage door lift.
H01754
(b)
(c)
Install the SST onto the torsion bar of the hinge side.
SST 09804–24010
Slowly lift the torsion bar with the SST and place it in the
torsion bar bracket.
H01755
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
2.
Slowly push the SST down and install the torsion bar to
the hinge.
Slowly lift the SST and install the torsion bar.
Install the torsion bar to the center bracket.
Repeat for the other side.
INSTALL PACKAGE TRAY TRIM
3.
4.
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
7.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
INSTALL HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
INSTALL THESE PARTS:
Room partition trims
Rear seat
Inner cover trims
LH and RH rear floor finish side plates
Luggage compartment floor mat
INSTALL LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR
Install the door with 4 bolts.
Install clamps.
Connect the connector.
INSTALL LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR TRIM
H01756
: 4 clips
N21430
Author:
Date:
2381
BO–34
BODY
Full Open
1/2 Open
Pop–Up
H01757
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
8.
CHECK LUGGAGE DOOR LIFT
Pop–up distance:
35 – 100 mm
Pop– up to 1/2 open:
Door should remain in any
position.
Past 1/2 open:
Door should open fully by
itself.
Full open position:
Door should not easily fall
closed
If adjustment is necessary, refer to step 2 –(a) above.
Author:
Date:
2382
BO–35
BODY
–
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER
BO0LK–01
COMPONENTS
Cowl Louver RH
24 (245, 18)
Wiper Motor
Wiper
Arms
Cowl Louver LH
Weatherstrip
Wiper
Link
Wiper Motor
Assembly
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Window
Washer Nozzle
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf)
: Specified torque
N21119
Author:
Date:
2383
BO–36
BODY
–
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER
BO0LL–01
REMOVAL
N20998
1.
REMOVE WIPER ARMS
2.
REMOVE WEATHERSTRIP AND COWL LOUVERS
3.
REMOVE WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 5 bolts and wiper motor assembly.
4.
REMOVE WIPER MOTOR
Remove the 2 bolts, then separate the motor crank arm from the
wiper links at the ball and socket joint.
5.
REMOVE WINDOW WASHER NOZZLE
(a) Remove the hoses from the nozzles.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the nozzle.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
BO4391
Author:
Date:
2384
BO–37
BODY
–
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER
BO0LM–01
ADJUSTMENT
B
B
D
1.
(a)
C
C
B
INSPECT WASHER NOZZLE
While operating the washer, check that the washer fluid
hits the windshield and the upsurge area within the
shaded areas.
B
U.S. mm (in.)
E
A
U.S.
F
A
B
H01773
”a”
280 (11)
600 (23.6)
”B”
150 (5.9)
150 (5.9)
”C”
50 (2.0)
250 (9.8)
50 (2.0) Max
”E”
180 (7.1)
360 (14)
”F”
395 (15.5)
114 (4.5)
”b”
D
F
C
Canada
”A”
”D”
B
Canada mm (in.), Approx.
A
G
E
(b)
H
H01774
(c)
90 (3.5)
”H”
474 (18.7)
”I”
350 (13.8)
Canadian models:
Adust the nozzle so the outboard points ”a” and ”b” are
within the wipe pattern.
Check if the lower point where the washer fluid hits the
windshield is within the range of the wiping pattern (the
area of the glass the wiper blades wipe).
2.
ADJUST WASHER NOZZLE
Using a tool like that shown in the illustration, rotate the nozzle
to adjust the fluid direction against the windshield.
2 – 2.5 mm
(0.079 – 0.098 in.)
0.7 – 0.75 mm
(0. 028 – 0.030 in.)
”G”
BE3367
Author:
Date:
2385
BO–38
BODY
–
FRONT WIPER AND WASHER
BO0LN–01
INSTALLATION
1.
2.
3.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL WINDOW WASHER NOZZLE
INSTALL WIPER LINK TO MOTOR
INSTALL THESE PARTS:
Wiper motor assembly
Torque: 5.5 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
Cowl louvers and weatherstrip
N20998
4.
(a)
”A”
”A”
Cowl Louver Edge
H01772
INSTALL WIPER ARMS
Operate the wipers once and turn the wiper switch OFF,
then install the wiper arms.
HINT:
If the driver’s side wiper arm mount has a blue dot on it, use an
ITT wiper arm. If there is no mark, use a ND wiper arm.
(b) Adjust the installation position of the wiper arms as shown
(blade tip to cowl louver edge).
”A” Approx. 35 mm (1.4 in.)
(c) Tighten the wiper arm nut.
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2386
BO–39
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
BO0M8–01
COMPONENTS
Front Door
Outside Moulding
Rear Quarter
Outside Moulding
Front Fender
Outside Moulding
Front Quarter
Outside Moulding
Rear Door Outside Moulding
N22598
Author:
Date:
2387
BO–40
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
BO0M9–01
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Store in a cool place, avoiding direct sunlight, high
temperature and dust.
The moulding is made of polyvinyl chloride. Do not allow this material to come in contact with thinner or
other solvents, open flame or boiling water.
The storage time for the moulding and adhesive is
limited to about 9 months.
1.
REMOVE ENDS OF MOULDING
Using a scraper, pry the moulding loose about 30 mm (1.18 in.)
form each end.
HINT:
Tape the scraper tip before using.
H01782
2.
REMOVE MOULDING AND ADHESIVE
(a) Pull off the moulding by cutting the adhesive with a knife.
(b) Scrape off adhesive from the body with sandpaper cutter.
NOTICE:
Remember that 30 – 80 mm (1.18 – 3.15 in.) of the ends
of the moulding are glued tightly with a strong adhesive.
Do not reuse moulding.
H01783
Author:
Date:
2388
BO–41
BODY
–
BODY OUTSIDE MOULDING
BO0MA–01
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
HEAT BODY MOUNTING SURFACE
Using a heat light, heat the body mounting surface to
40 – 60 °C (104 – 140 °F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat body excessively.
(b) Remove the adhesive tape from the body.
(c) Wipe off stains with cleaner.
BO6675
N19058
2.
CLEAN MOULDING
If reusing the moulding:
(a) Using a heat light, heat the moulding to 20 – 30 °C (68 –
86 °F).
NOTICE:
Do not heat moulding excessively.
(b) Remove the adhesive tape from the moulding.
(c) Wipe off stains with cleaner.
(d) Apply a new adhesive tape to moulding as shown in the
illustration.
Adhesive Tape
Adhesive Tape
H01884
3.
(a)
N22643
INSTALL MOULDING
Using a heat light, heat the body and moulding.
Body: 40 – 60 °C (104 – 140 °F)
Moulding: 20 – 30 °C (68 – 86 °F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat moulding excessively.
(b) Lift moulding release sheet from face of moulding.
NOTICE:
When the moulding release sheet is removed, make sure
that no dirt or dust can get onto the uncoated area.
(c) Align the bosses with their corresponding holes in the
body, and press firmly on the moulding. Refer to the illustration for the front fender moulding application procedures.
NOTICE:
Do not apply excessive force onto the moulding, but steady
pressure with your thumbs.
Author:
Date:
2389
BO–42
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
WINDSHIELD
BO0LO–01
COMPONENTS
Inside Rear
View Mirror
Map Light Assembly
Sun Visor
Front Pillar Garnish
Weatherstrip
Sun Visor
Windshield
Glass
Holder
Windshield Upper Moulding
Stopper
Weatherstrip
Dam
Windshield
Outside
Moulding
Wiper Arm
Cowl Louver RH
24 (245, 18)
Windshield
Outside
Cowl Louver LH Moulding
Front Pillar Garnish
Weatherstrip
Hood
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
N20947
Author:
Date:
2390
BO–43
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
BO0LP–01
REMOVAL
N20982
1.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
(a) Inner rear view mirror
(b) Sun visors and holders
(c) Map light assembly
(d) Front pillar garnishes
(e) Hood
(f)
Wiper arms
(g) Cowl louvers
(h) Weatherstrips
2.
REMOVE WEATHERSTRIP
Remove the weatherstrip by pulling.
HINT:
Remove only the front half of weatherstrip.
3.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING
(a) Using a drill of less than ø 5.0 mm (0.20 in.), drill out the
rivet heads and remove the moulding.
(b) Using a vacuum cleaner, remove the drill rivet and their
dust from the inside of the door.
CAUTION:
The cut rivet and rivet cutter will be not, avoid touching
them.
NOTICE:
Do not jiggle the rivet cutter while cutting.You may enlarge
the rivet hole or damage the rivet cutter.
HINT:
Do not drill the body.
Sealant may cause the moulding to stick to the glass. If necessary, separate from the glass using a knife.
4.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD UPPER MOULDING
Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the body with the knife.
N20983
5.
(a)
REMOVE WINDSHIELD GLASS
Push piano wire through between the body and glass
from the interior.
Tie both wire ends to a wooden block or a similar object.
(b)
HINT:
Apply adhesive tape to the outer surface to prevent scratching.
BO5232
Author:
Date:
2391
BO–44
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
NOTICE:
When separating the glass, be careful not to damage the
paint and interior and exterior ornaments. To prevent
scratching the safety pad when removing the windshield,
place a plastic sheet between the piano wire and safety
pad.
(c) Cut the adhesive by pulling the piano wire around it.
(d) Remove the glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much of the adhesive on the body as possible
when removing the glass.
6.
REMOVE RETAINERS
BO1689
Author:
Date:
2392
BO–45
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
BO0LQ–01
INSTALLATION
Adhesive
BO4420
1.
CLEAN AND SHAPE CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY
(a) Using a knife, cut away any rough areas on the body.
HINT:
Leave as much of the adhesive on the body as possible.
(b) Clean the cutting surface of the adhesive with a piece of
shop rag saturated in cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed, clean the body.
2.
(a)
(b)
REPLACE STOPPER
Remove the damaged stopper.
Cut off the old adhesive around the stopper installation
area.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
(c) Clean the installation area.
(d) Install a new stopper onto the body.
N21015
3.
(a)
CLEAN REMOVED GLASS
Using a scraper, remove the adhesive sticking to the
glass.
(b) Clean the glass with cleaner.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass after cleaning it.
BO5231
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
POSITION GLASS
Place glass in the correct position.
Check that all contacting parts of the glass rim are perfectly even and do not make contact with the fasteners.
Place reference marks between the glass and body.
Remove the glass.
BO2820
5.
CLEAN CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS
Using a cleaner, clean the contact surface black–colored area
around the entire glass rim.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass face after cleaning it.
BO4421
Author:
Date:
2393
BO–46
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
6.
INSTALL DAM
Install the dam with double–stick tape as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass face after cleaning it.
A: 7 mm (0.276 in.)
A
N21016
7.
Primer ”M”
COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY WITH PRIMER
”M”
Using a brush, coat the contact surface on the body with Primer
M.
NOTICE:
Let the primer coating dry for 3 minutes or more. Do not
coat Primer M to the adhesive. Do not keep any of the
opened Primer M for later use.
Primer ”M”
N00141
8.
COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS WITH PRIMER
”G”
(a) Using a brush or a sponge, coat the edge of the glass and
the contact surface with Primer G.
(b) Before the primer dries, wipe it off with a clean shop rag.
NOTICE:
Let the primer coating dry for 3 minutes or more. Do not
keep any of the opened Primer G for later use.
Primer G
N21017
9.
(a)
12.5 mm or more
(0.492 in.)
APPLY ADHESIVE
Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle. Fill the cartridge with
adhesive.
Part No. 08850 – 00801 or equivalent
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within the time described in the chart below.
8.0 mm or more
(0.315 in.) N21018
Temperature
(b)
(c)
Tackfree time
35 °C (95 °F)
15 minute
20 °C (68 °F)
100 minute
5 °C (41 °F)
8 hour
Load the cartridge into the sealer gun.
Coat the glass with adhesive as shown.
Author:
Date:
2394
BO–47
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
10. INSTALL GLASS
HINT:
Confirm that the dam is attached the body panel as shown in
the illustration.
Adhesive
N21019
(a)
(b)
Position the glass so that the reference marks are lined
up, and press in gently along the rim.
Using a spatula, apply adhesive on the glass rim.
BO2821
(c)
Use a scraper to remove any excess or protruding adhesive.
NOTICE:
Take care not to drive the vehicle during the time described
in the chart below.
BO3986
(d)
11.
(a)
(b)
12.
Temperature
Minimum time prior to drive the vehicle
35 °C (95 °F)
1.5 hour
20 °C (68 °F)
5 hour
5 °C (41 °F)
24 hour
Hold the windshield glass in place securely with a protective tape or equivalent until the adhesive hardened.
INSPECT FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
Do a leak test after the hardening time has elapsed.
Seal any leak with sealant.
Part No. 08833 – 00030 or equivalent
APPLY ADHESIVE AT MOULDING INSTALLATION
AREA
Part No. 08833 – 00030 or equivalent
Adhesive
Adhesive
BO3671
Author:
Date:
2395
BO–48
BODY
–
WINDSHIELD
13. INSTALL WINDSHIELD UPPER MOULDING
Place the moulding onto the body and tap it in by hand.
N22592
14.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL WINDSHIELD OUTSIDE MOULDING
Install the pawl of the outside moulding to the upper
moulding to set the moulding to the body.
Using an air riveter with nose piece, install the new 3 rivets
and outside moulding.
N20984
20 mm
(0.79 in.)
N15432
CAUTION:
To avoid personal injury and short of the wiring when
installing ø 5.0 mm (0.20 in.) rivets keep your hands out of
the 20 mm (0.79 in.) radius that the caulked ø 5.0 mm (0.20
in.) rivet will cover.
HINT:
Install the rivet firmly pressed at a right angle (90°) against the
installation hole.
15. INSTALL THESE PARTS:
(a) Cowl louvers
(b) Weatherstrips
(c) Wiper arms
Torque: 24 N·m (245 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(d) Front pillar garnishes
(e) Map light assembly
(f)
Sun visors and holders
(g) Inner rear view mirror
Author:
Date:
2396
BO–49
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BO0LR–01
COMPONENTS
Back Window Moulding
Back Window Glass
Dam
Roof Side
Inner Garnish
Rear Seatback
19 (185, 13)
Rear Side Seat
Back LH
Rear Side Seat
Back RH
19 (185, 13)
High–Mounted
Stop Light
19 (185, 13)
Rear Seat Cushion
Rear Seat Outer Belt
Rear Seat Center Belt
Package Tray
Trim
Rear Seat Outer Belt
42 (420, 31)
Non–reusable part
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Room Partition Trim
N20948
Author:
Date:
2397
BO–50
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BO0LS–01
REMOVAL
3 Clips
1 Clip
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION AND SEATBACKS
REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISHES
Remove the clips.
Pull the garnish to remove it.
3.
(a)
REMOVE HIGH–MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
Push on the both side of the cover to release the claws by
your hand and remove the cover as shown in the illustration.
Remove the 2 bolts and stop light, then disconnect the
connector.
N21020
(b)
N22588
4 Clips
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE PACKAGE TRAY TRIM
Remove the bolts holding the rear seat belt lower side to
the body.
Remove the seat belts with seat belt hole covers from the
package trim.
Remove the trim by pulling forward.
N21021
5.
REMOVE ROOM PARTITION TRIMS
Remove the 6 clips and room partition trims.
6.
REMOVE THESE PARTS
(a) Assist grips.
(b) Rear side of roof headlining.
7.
DISCONNECT DEFOGGER WIRE CONNECTORS
N21121
8.
REMOVE BACK WINDOW MOULDING
Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the body with the knife.
9.
REMOVE BACK WINDOW GLASS
Remove the glass in the same way as windshield.
(See page BO–43)
N20985
Author:
Date:
2398
BO–51
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BO0LT–01
INSTALLATION
HINT:
Refer to the installation of windshield, install back window glass
by the following operations.
(See page BO–45)
1.
CLEAN AND SHAPE CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY
2.
CLEAN REMOVED GLASS
N21122
3.
REPLACE STOPPERS
4.
POSITION GLASS
5.
CLEAN CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS
6.
INSTALL DAM
Install the dam with double–stick tape as show in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass face after cleaning it.
7.
COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY WITH PRIMER
”M”
8.
COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS WITH PRIMER
”G”
9.
APPLY ADHESIVE AT MOULDING INSTALLATION
AREA
Adhesive
Adhesive
BO3671
N20986
10. INSTALL BACK WINDOW MOULDING
Place the moulding onto the body and tap it by hand.
11. APPLY ADHESIVE
12. INSTALL GLASS
13. INSPECT FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
14. CONNECT DEFOGGER CONNECTORS
15. INSTALL THESE PARTS:
(a) Rear side of roof headlining
(b) Assist grips
(c) Package tray trim
Author:
Date:
2399
BO–52
BODY
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
Room partition trims
Seat belt lower side bolts
Torque: 42 N·m (420 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
High–mounted stop light
Roof side inner garnish
Rear seatbacks and seat cushion
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2400
BO–53
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
BO0M1–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
N10192
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF GLASS ALIGNMENT
(a) Start the engine and check the operation time of the sliding roof.
Operation time:
Approx. 6 secs.
(b) Check for abnormal noise or binding during operation.
(c) With the sliding roof fully closed, check for water leakage.
(d) Check for a difference in level between the sliding roof
weatherstrip and roof panel.
Except rear end:
0 ± 1.5 mm (0 ± 0.059 in.)
Rear end:
0 + 1.5 mm (0 + 0.059 in.)
0 – 1.0 mm (0 – 0.039 in.)
Author:
Date:
2401
BO–54
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
BO0M2–01
COMPONENTS
Side Garnish
Sliding Roof Glass
Rear Roof
Drip Channel
Roof Window
Deflector Panel
Side Garnish
Drive Cable
Guide Block
Guide Block
Sliding Roof
Housing
Drive Gear
Guide Rail Stopper
Sunshade Trim
Sliding Roof
Panel Stopper
Roof Rail
Rear Frame
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
N22654
Author:
Date:
2402
BO–55
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
BO0M3–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING
(See page BO–83)
2.
REMOVE SIDE GARNISH
Using a screwdriver, remove the garnishes.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF GLASS ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a torx wrench, remove the 4 screws.
(b) Pull the glass upward to remove it.
4.
REMOVE DRIVE GEAR
NOTICE:
Remove the drive gear with the sliding roof is full closed.
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and drive gear.
N21524
(c)
(d)
Remove the screw and cam plate cover.
Turn the drive gear to align the point marks as shown in
the illustration.
(e) Install the cam plate cover and screw.
NOTICE:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
If the sliding roof position and drive gear full close position
is not matched, the sliding roof does not operate normally.
Point Marks
N21527
Author:
Date:
2403
BO–56
BODY
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
Disconnect the 4 drain hoses from the housing.
Remove the 8 bolts and 4 brackets.
Torque: 5.5 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
Remove the 6 nuts, then remove the housing as shown
on the following page.
N21529
Author:
Date:
2404
BO–57
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
BO0M4–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF PANEL STOPPER
Remove the 2 screws and 2 stoppers.
2.
REMOVE SUNSHADE TRIM
N21523
3.
REMOVE REAR ROOF DRIP CHANNEL
Remove the rear roof drip channel as shown in the illustration.
N21421
4.
REMOVE REAR FRAME
Remove the 4 screws and rear frame.
N21424
5.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE DRIVE CABLE
Remove the screw and guide rail stopper.
Slide the drive cable rearward, then remove it.
N21526
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following items.
Adjust the drive cable to a closed and tilted down position.
Slide the cable forward or backward to align the 2 marks
as shown.
Slide the cable to the forefront with your hand.
6.
REMOVE ROOF WINDOW DEFLECTOR PANEL
N21525
Author:
Date:
2405
BO–58
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
7.
REMOVE GUIDE BLOCK
Remove the 2 screws and guide block.
N21420
8.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING
Remove the 6 screws and sliding roof housing.
N21522
Author:
Date:
2406
BO–59
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
BO0M5–01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
REMOVE SIDE GARNISH
Before making adjustments, using a screwdriver, remove the
side garnishes.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
After adjustment, reinstall the side garnishes.
N21422
2.
(a)
(b)
TO ADJUST FORWARD OR REARWARD
Using a torx wrench, loosening the sliding roof glass
installation screws.
Adjust the sliding roof glass forward and rearward.
Z04207
3.
TO ADJUST CLEARANCE
(Difference in left and right clearance)
(a) When the front or rear alignment is not correct, remove
the drive gear and sliding roof glass, then adjust the drive
rail.
NOTICE:
Remove the drive gear with sliding roof is full closed.
BO3396
(b)
(c)
Adjust by slide the cable forward or rearward to align the
2 marks as shown.
Install the drive gear and sliding roof glass.
N21525
Author:
Date:
2407
BO–60
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
BO0M6–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–57).
Author:
Date:
2408
BO–61
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMC Made)
BO0M7–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–55).
Author:
Date:
2409
BO–62
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
BO0LU–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
H01814
Glass Panel
Level Difference ± 1.5 mm
Roof Panel
Weatherstrip
H01815
INSPECT SLIDING ROOF GLASS ALIGNMENT
(a) Start the engine and check the operation time of the sliding roof.
Operation time:
Approximately 6 sec.
(b) Check for abnormal noise or binding during operation.
(c) Check for water leakage with the sliding roof fully closed.
(d)
Check the alignment between the sliding roof weatherstrip and the roof panel.
All sides:
0 ± 1.5 mm (0 ± 0.059 in.)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
To align the glass to the roof surface, loosen the 4 screws, then
adjust and retighten.
If the sliding roof does not operate:
(e) Remove the map light assembly.
(f)
Manually operate the sliding roof by inserting a hex
wrench into the motor to turn the drive shaft.
H01816
Author:
Date:
2410
BO–63
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
BO0LV–01
COMPONENTS
Sliding Roof
Sliding Roof Glass
Sunroof Opening Trim
Headliner Assembly
Room Light
Map Light Assembly
H01812
Author:
Date:
2411
BO–64
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
Wind deflector
Roof Drip Channel
Deflector Spring
RH Lift Arm and Cable
Assembly
RH Roof Drip Channel
Guide
LH Roof Drip Channel
Guide
Sunshade Trim
LH Lift Arm and Cable
Assembly
Drain Cap
Drive Rail Assembly
5.5 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H01813
Author:
Date:
2412
BO–65
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
BO0LW–01
REMOVAL
1.
H01824
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING
(See page BO–83)
REMOVE SIDE GARNISHES
2.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Soak the garnishes in water to soften them before assembly.
3.
REMOVE GLASS PANEL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 glass panel adjustment screws.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Adjust the height of the glass panel, then tighten the 4 screws.
(b) Pull the glass upward to remove it.
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF ASSEMBLY
Remove the 4 drain hoses from the sliding roof assembly.
Remove the 8 bolts and 4 brackets.
Torque: 5.5 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
Remove the 6 nuts and the sliding roof assembly.
H01825
Author:
Date:
2413
BO–66
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
BO0LX–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SLIDING ROOF HOUSING DRAIN CAP
Pull the drain cap rearward to remove it.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Apply seal packing to the drain cap.
Seal packing:
Part No.1 08826 – 00090 or equivalent
2.
REMOVE REAR ROOF DRIP CHANNEL
Unclip the roof drip channel from the roof drip channel guide.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Aligh the rear roof drip channel to the roof drip channel guide
hook.
3.
REMOVE SUNSHADE TRIM
H01826
4.
(a)
REMOVE LH AND RH ROOF DRIP CHANNEL GUIDE
Using a screwdriver, remove the guide from the lift arm assembly.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before using.
(b) Slide the guide out of the side rail.
H01827
5.
(a)
H01828
REMOVE DRIVE GEAR ASSEMBLY
Use a hex wrench to align the gear pointer with the housing pointer.
Disconnect the harness connector.
Remove the 3 screws and the drive gear assembly.
(b)
(c)
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Aligh the drive gear assembly during reassembly.
(See page BO–68).
H01829
Author:
Date:
2414
BO–67
BODY
6.
(a)
H01830
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
REMOVE LH AND RH SIDING ROOF LIFT ARM AND
CABLE ASSEMBLIES
Using a drill, cut the flange portion of the stop pin (rivet)
from each side rail.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Use two new rivets.
(b) Slide the LH sliding roof lift arm and drive cable from its
side rail.
(c) Slide the RH sliding roof lift arm and drive cable from its
side rail.
7.
REMOVE WIND DEFLECTOR
(a) Remove the 2 screws from the front rail assembly.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Insert the strap into the front rail assembly as shown.
H01831
H01832
(b) Using a drill, cut the flange portion of the 4 rivets.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the side rail (rivet) holes when
drilling.
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item.
Use 4 new special sealing type rivets.
Part No. 09884–26003
(c) Remove the deflector and spring assembly.
(d) Remove the spring from the deflector.
Author:
Date:
2415
BO–68
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
BO0LY–01
ADJUSTMENT
Motor Housing
Pointer (Grey) Gear Pointer (Brown)
1.
ALIGN THE MOTOR TO ”O” POSITION
NOTICE:
The ”O” position is the same as the sliding roof ”flush ”
position (sliding roof closed).
Use the vehicle sliding roof switch or a hex wrench to align the
gear pointer with the motor housing pointer as shown.
H01817
NOTICE:
Use only the sliding roof switch to electrically operate the
motor or sliding roof. Do not use any other electrical
source to power the motor. If the sliding roof switch (under
vehicle power) is not available, use a hex wrench to align
the motor pointers.
2.
REMOVE DRIVE GEAR ASSEMBLY
H01818
3.
REMOVE GLASS PANEL
(a) Remove the 4 glass panels adjustment screws.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Adjust the height of the glass panel, then tighten the 4 screws.
(b) Pull the glass upward to remove it.
H01819
Parts shown
disassembled
for clarity
4.
ALIGN SLIDING ROOF COMPONENTS
(a) Verify the hook appears as shown.
(b) Align the cable arm hole with the lift arm hole.
HINT:
Using a screwdriver, move the LH and RH cable assemblies forward and backward to align the holes in the cable arm and lifter
arm.
(c) Temporarily insert a 3 mm (0.12 in.) pin through the alignment holes in the cable arm and lifter arm.
HINT:
Verify the cam block alignment hole is aligned with the lift arm
alignment hole. Misalignment at this point will result in a malfunction of the sliding roof mechanism.
5.
REINSTALL DRIVE GEAR ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Before reinstalling the drive gear assembly, double check the
alignment of the gear pointers.
H01820
Author:
Date:
2416
BO–69
BODY
6.
(a)
OK
NG
H01821
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
VERIFY CORRECT INSTALLATION TIMING
Cycle the unit once (vent position closed, slide open, slide
completely closed).
HINT:
After cycling the unit closed from the slide open position, verify
the alignment holes in the cable arm and cam block are aligned
and the motor pointers are in the ”O” position.
The timing of the sliding roof is okay if the holes are within
1/2 a diameter of each other as shown when closed from
the ”side open” position.
NOTICE:
The holes will normally not align when moving the sliding
roof from the vent open position to the closed position.
(b)
Lift Arm Assembly
Guide Pin
Slide Rail
H01822
There should be a slight interference between the guide
pin and the curved ”lead–in” of the side rail. Confirm by
cycling the unit. A clicking sound from the hook indicates
the adjustment is incorrect.
If the guide pin has been disturbed, readjust as follows:
(1) Loosen the screw and adjust the pin so there is a
slight interference.
(2) Tighten the screw and cycle the unit.
(3) Confirm the hook smoothly engages the wind deflector spring.
(4) Repeat if necessary.
7.
REINSTALL GLASS PANEL
Hook
H01823
Author:
Date:
2417
BO–70
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
BO0LZ–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–66).
Author:
Date:
2418
BO–71
BODY
–
SLIDING ROOF (TMMK Made)
BO0M0–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–65).
NOTICE:
Check and adjust the sliding roof after installation (See page BO–62).
Author:
Date:
2419
BO–72
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL
BO0MB–01
COMPONENTS
N
Instrument Panel Reinforcement
G
G
N
N
N
G
Instrument Panel Brace Mount
H Q Q
No.2 Instrumental Panel Brace
N
N
B O
No.1 Instrument
Panel Brace
N
N
N
Front Pillar Garnish
N
Front
Passenger
Airbag
Assembly
Front Pillar
Garnish
D
No.2 Instrumental Panel Bracket
No.1 Instrumental Panel Bracket
D
20 (200, 14)
No.2 Side Defroster Nozzle
Cowl Side Trim
Front Door Opening
Cover
Front Door
Inside Scuff Plate
Glove Compartment
Door Finish Plate
Instrument Panel
C
Hazard Warning
Switch
Lower Finish
Remote Control
Mirror Hole Base
Plate
Upper Column
Cover
A
F
F
J
F
F
Glove
Compartment
A
No.2 Lower
Panel
Cluster Finish
Panel
Radio Assembly
Combination Switch
Lower Column
Cover
D
Front Door
Opening
Cover
Cowl Side
Trim
D
Center Cluster
Finish Panel
35 (360, 26)
D
D
No.1 Lower
Panel
F
A
A
Steering Wheel
D
Lower Panel
Insert
Combination
Meter
Coin
Box
Front Console
Box
Center Console
Front Door
Upper Panel
Inside Scuff Plate
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Author:
A/C
Control Assembly
Steering
Wheel
Pad
F
F
B
B
Rear Console
Box
N20950
Date:
2420
BO–73
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
Instrument Panel Wire Harness
No.1 Defroster Nozzle Garnish
A
Defroster Nozzle Assembly
A
RH Side Defroster Duct Nozzle
No.1
Side Defroster
Duct Nozzle
No.2 Heater Duct to
K Register
A
A
A
A
No.3 Instrument
Panel Register
Assembly
K
A
A
K
K
A
No.1 Heater Duct to
Register
A A
K
K
A
Instrument
Panel Center
Bracket
No.2 Instrument
Panel Register
Assembly
No.1 Instrument Panel
Regigter Assembly
Glove Box
Light Assembly
Instrument Panel
N20951
Author:
Date:
2421
BO–74
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
HINT:
Screw shapes and size are indicated in the table below. The code (”A”–”P”) correspond to those indicated
on the previous page.
mm (in.)
Code
Shape
Size
Code
ø = 5.2 (0.21)
A
B
L = 16 (0.63)
D
ø = 6.0 (0.24)
ø = 8.0 (0.31)
E
ø = 5.0 (0.20)
L = 20 (0.79)
ø = 5.2 (0.21)
F
L = 20 (0.79)
ø = 6.0 (0.24)
L = 20 (0.79)
L = 20 (0.79)
ø = 5.0 (0.20)
L = 18 (0.79)
ø = 5.0 (0.20)
L
L = 14 (0.55)
L = 12 (0.47)
6 x 1.00
8 x 1.25
ø = 8.0 (0.31)
Size
ø = 6.0 (0.24)
C
I
K
L = 18 (0.17)
Shape
ø = 6.0 (0.24)
H
ø = 6.0 (0.24)
M
ø = 6.0 (0.24)
Code
L = 10 (0.39)
L = 22 (0.87)
J
Size
L = 16 (0.63)
L = 20 (0.79)
G
Shape
N
O
6 x 1.00
P
H01983
Author:
Date:
2422
BO–75
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
BO0MC–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
HINT:
Tape a screwdriver tip before use.
(a) Front door inside scuff plates
(b) Cowl side trims
(c) Front pillar garnishes
(d) Front door opening covers
(e) Lower finish plate
2.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL
(See page SR–11)
3.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVERS
(a) Remove the steering tilt handle.
(b) Remove the 3 screws, then the upper and lower column
covers.
4.
REMOVE COMBINATION SWITCH
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE No.1 LOWER PANEL
Remove the 2 screws and hood lock release lever.
Press on the sides of the coin box while pulling the coin
box outward, and remove the coin box.
Remove the screw, bolt and the No.1 lower panel.
N20987
6.
(a)
(b)
7.
REMOVE LOWER PANEL INSERT
Remove the 2 screws holding the DLC3 to the LH lower
panel.
Remove the 4 bolts, and the panel.
REMOVE No.2 LOWER COVER
N21123
Author:
Date:
2423
BO–76
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
8.
(a)
N20988
7 Clips
N21023
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT ASSEMBLY
Using a screwdriver, remove the glove compartment door
finish plate to the glove compartment box inside.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, be careful not to damage the airbag wire harness.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Pull up and disconnect the airbag connector.
(c) Remove the 4 screws, bolt and glove compartment assembly.
9.
REMOVE CENTER CONSOLE UPPER PANEL
Using a screwdriver, remove the panel, then disconnect the
connector.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
10. REMOVE REAR CONSOLE BOX
Remove the 2 bolts, 2 screws and the console box.
11. REMOVE CENTER CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
Using a screwdriver, remove the panel, then disconnect the
connector.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before using.
12. REMOVE FRONT CONSOLE BOX
Remove the 2 screws and the front console box.
13. REMOVE RADIO ASSEMBLY
14. REMOVE A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
(See page AC–82)
15. REMOVE HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
16. REMOVE CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the panel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
17. REMOVE COMBINATION METER
18. REMOVE REMOTE CONTROL MIRROR HOLE BASE
6 Clips
N21024
Author:
Date:
2424
BO–77
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
19.
W03509
REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(See page RS–28)
Remove the 2 bolts, 4 nuts and the front passenger airbag assembly.
Torque:
Bolt: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
CAUTION:
Store the front passenger airbag door facing upward
(never downward).
Never disassemble the front passenger airbag assembly.
NOTICE:
The 2 bolts to the instrument panel have been anti–rust
treated. After removing the front passenger airbag assembly, always replace the bolts and nuts with new ones.
20.
REMOVE No.1 AND No.2 INSTRUMENT PANEL
BRACKETS
Remove the 4 bolts and the No.1 and No.2 panel brackets.
21. REMOVE NO.2 SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE
N20991
22.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL ASSEMBLY
Disconnect the connectors from the LH and RH connector
holders.
Remove the bolts holding the ground wire to the body.
Remove the connector holder from the body.
N20992
(d)
(e)
Disconnect the connectors.
Remove the bolt holding the ground wire to the No.2
instrument panel brace.
N20993
Author:
Date:
2425
BO–78
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
(f)
Remove the bolt, nut, screw and the instrument panel assembly.
23.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACES
Remove the wire brackets and connector.
Remove the bolt and connector from the No.1 instrument
panel brace.
w/ Wireless Control:
Remove the nut and the wireless control unit from the
No.1 instrument panel brace.
Remove the nut holding the radio antenna to the No.2
instrument panel brace.
Remove a nut and brace mount bracket.
Remove the 6 nuts, 2 bolts and No.1 and No.2 instrument
panel braces.
N20994
(c)
(d)
N20995
(e)
(f)
24.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
N20996
(f)
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
Remove the connectors from the steering column tube.
Remove the 4 wire brackets and connectors.
Remove the 2 nuts and bolt holding the No.1 Junction Box
(J/B) to the reinforcement.
Remove the 4 nuts and the steering column from the reinforcement.
Remove the brake pedal spring from the reinforcement
and brake pedal.
Remove the 4 nuts, 3 bolts and the reinforcement.
N20997
Author:
Date:
2426
BO–79
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
BO0MD–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
No.1 defroster nozzle garnish
No.1 defroster nozzle
RH side defroster duct nozzle
No.1 side defroster duct nozzle
No.1 heater duct to register
No.2 heater duct to register
No.2 register assembly
No.3 register assembly
No.1 register assembly
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE HARNESS
Remove the 2 brackets, 8 clips and wire harness.
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL CENTER BRACKET
4.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
(a) Clock unit
(b) Glove box light assembly
N21124
Author:
Date:
2427
BO–80
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
BO0ME–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–79).
Author:
Date:
2428
BO–81
BODY
–
INSTRUMENT PANEL
BO0MF–01
INSTALLATION
Reassembly is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–75).
Author:
Date:
2429
BO–82
BODY
–
ROOF HEADLINING
ROOF HEADLINING
BO0MG–01
COMPONENTS
Assist Grip
Roof Headlining
Sun Visor
Map Light
Assembly
Assist Grip
Holder
Cover
Room Light
Holder
Sun Visor
Center Pillar Garnish
Front Pillar Garnish
Roof Side Inner Garnish
Rear Side Seat
Back RH
42 (420, 31)
Lower Center
Pillar Garnish
Front Door Scuff
Plate
Rear Seat
Side Garnish
Rear Seatback
Rear Side Seat
Back LH
18 (185, 13)
42 (420, 31)
18 (185, 13)
Rear Seat Cushion
Center Pillar Garnish
42 (420, 31)
18 (185, 13)
42 (420, 31)
Roof Seat
Side Garnish
Front Pillar Garnish
Rear Seat
Side Garnish
42 (420, 31)
Lower Center
Pillar Garnish
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Front Door Scuff
Plate
N22600
Author:
Date:
2430
BO–83
BODY
–
ROOF HEADLINING
BO0MH–01
REMOVAL
: 4 Clips
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
2.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
Rear seat cushion
Rear seatback and rear side seatbacks
Front door scuff plates
Front seat belt shoulder anchor bolts
Sun visor and holders
Assist grips
Front pillar garnishes
Rear door scuff plates
Lower center pillar garnishes
REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
(See page BO–28)
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
Pry out clips by your hand.
Pull the garnish upward to remove it.
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH
Remove the clip.
Pry off the garnish.
N21457
: Clip
: 2 Clips
N21458
5.
REMOVE ROOM LIGHT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the room light cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 4 screws, then disconnect the connector.
6.
REMOVE MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
N21415
Author:
Date:
2431
BO–84
BODY
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2 Clips
–
ROOF HEADLINING
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING
Remove the 2 clips from the roof panel rear end.
Remove the headlining.
Bring out the headlining.
N22971
Author:
Date:
2432
BO–85
BODY
–
ROOF HEADLINING
BO0MI–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–83).
Author:
Date:
2433
BO–85
BODY
–
ROOF HEADLINING
BO0MI–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–83).
Author:
Date:
2433
BO–86
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMC Made)
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMC Made)
BO0MJ–01
COMPONENTS
Headrest
Seatback Frame
Headrest Support
Hog Ring
Hinge Cover
18 (185, 13)
Seatback Cover
6.0 (61, 53 in.·lbf)
w/ Side Airbag Assembly
Side Airbag Assembly
Seatback Pad
15 (150, 11)
Seat Cushion Cover
Seat Cushion Pad
Lumber Support Adjuster
Seat Cushion Frame
37 (375, 27)
Hog Ring
Power Seat Adjuster
37 (375, 27)
Seat Track Cover
Front Vertical
Motor
Power Seat Switch
Seat Cushion Shield
Switch Knob
Rear Vertical Motor
Reclining Motor
Lower Seat Cushion Shield
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
H01977
Author:
Date:
2434
BO–87
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMC Made)
BO0MK–01
REMOVAL
REMOVE FRONT SEAT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the seat track covers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts.
(c) Disconnect the connector.
(d) Remove the front seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
Author:
Date:
2435
BO–88
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMC Made)
BO0ML–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
Headrest
Switch knobs
Seat cushion shield
Lower seat cushion shield
Power seat switch
REMOVE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
Remove the 3 clips of the side airbag wire harness from
the seat cushion frame.
Remove the 4 bolts and seatback assembly.
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
H01870
REMOVE SEATBACK COVER
Remove the hog rings and hooks.
Remove the hook as shown in the illustration.
Remove the headrest supports.
Remove the hog rings and seatback frame from seatback
cover with pad.
(e) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover from seatback
pad.
4.
REMOVE SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Remove the 1 clip of side airbag wire harness, 2 nuts and side
airbag assembly from the seatback frame.
CAUTION:
Do not store the side airbag assembly with the airbag
deployment direction facing down.
Never disassemble the side airbag assembly.
5.
REMOVE LUMBER SUPPORT ADJUSTER
Remove the 2 screws and lumber support adjuster.
6.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Remove the 4 bolts and seat cushion assembly.
7.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Remove the 2 clips, hook and seat cushion frame from
seat cushion cover with pad.
(b) Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover from the
seat cushion pad.
Author:
Date:
2436
BO–89
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMC Made)
8.
REMOVE REAR VERTICAL MOTOR
Remove the 2 screws and front vertical motor.
H01978
9.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE SLIDE MOTOR
Remove the 2 screws.
Disconnect the No.1 drive cable, then remove the slide
motor.
10.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE RECLINING MOTOR
Remove the 2 screws.
Disconnect the No.2 drive cable, then remove the reclining motor.
H01979
H01980
Author:
Date:
2437
BO–90
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMC Made)
BO0MM–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL RECLINING MOTOR
Connect the No.2 drive cable, then install the reclining motor
with 2 screws.
H01980
2.
INSTALL SLIDE MOTOR
Connect the No.1 drive cable, then install the slide motor with
2 screws.
H01979
H01978
3.
INSTALL REAR VERTICAL MOTOR
Install the front vertical motor with 2 screws.
4.
INSTALL LOWER SEAT CUSHION SHIELD
5.
INSTALL SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Install the seat cushion cover with new hog rings to seat
cushion pad.
(b) Install the seat cushion cover with pad to the seat cushion
frame with hook and 2 clips.
HINT:
Install the hog rings to prevent wrinkles as least as possible.
6.
INSTALL SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Install the seat cushion assembly with 4 bolts.
7.
INSTALL SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Install the side airbag assembly with 2 new nuts and 1 clip of
side airbag wire harness to the seatback frame.
Torque: 6.0 N·m (61 N·m, 53 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the side airbag assembly is installed
to the specified torque.
If the side airbag assembly has been dropped, or
there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case or
connector, replace the side airbag assembly with a
new one.
8.
INSTALL SEATBACK COVER
(a) Install the seatback cover with new hog rings to the seatback pad.
(b) Install the seatback cover with pad to the seatback frame
with new hog rings.
(c) Install the headrest supports.
Author:
Date:
2438
BO–91
BODY
H01870
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMC Made)
(d) Hang the hook onto the seatback frame.
CAUTION:
Take care to hung the hook securely. Otherwise the seat
cover slides, it might cause incorrect deploying.
9.
INSTALL SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the seatback assembly with 4 bolts.
(b) Install the 2 clips of the side airbag wire harness to the
seat cushion frame.
(c) Install a new hog rings and 7 hooks.
HINT:
Install the hog rings to prevent wrinkles as least as possible.
10. INSTALL THESE PARTS:
(a) Power seat switch
(b) Lower Seat cushion shield
(c) Seat cushion shield
(d) Switch knobs
(e) Headrest
Author:
Date:
2439
BO–92
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMC Made)
BO0MN–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–87).
Author:
Date:
2440
BO–93
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMMK Made)
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MU–01
COMPONENTS
Front Seatback Cover
Front Seatback
Headrest
Pad
Front Seat Cushion
Cover
Headrest
Support
Hog Ring
Front
Seatback
Hinge
Cover
Hog Ring
Front Seat Cushion
Inner No.1 Shield
Seatback Frame
Front SeatbackHingeCover
Front Seat Adjuster
Assembly
Front Seat Cushion
Pad
w/ Lumber Support:
Lumber Support Lever
Front Seat Cushion Frame
Front Power Seat
Switch
Front Seat Cushion
Shield
Front Seat Cushion
Bracket
Switch Knob
Seat Cushion Lower
Shield
w/ Side Airbag
Assembly:
6.0 (61, 53 in.·lbf)
Side Airbag Assembly
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
H01873
Author:
Date:
2441
BO–94
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MV–01
REMOVAL
REMOVE FRONT SEAT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the seat track covers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts.
(c) w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Disconnect the connector.
(d) Disconnect the front power seat connector.
(e) Remove the front seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
Author:
Date:
2442
BO–95
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MW–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
Switch knob
Front seat cushion shield
Front power seat switch
Seat cushion lower shield
w/ Lumber Support:
Lumber support lever
Headrest
Front seat inner belt
REMOVE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Remove the side airbag wire harness after removing
clips.
Remove the hog rings.
Remove the bolts and front seatback hinge cover.
Remove the seatback assembly.
3.
(a)
H01870
REMOVE SEATBACK COVER
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Remove the hook from the seatback frame.
(b) Remove the headrest supports.
(c) Remove the seatback frame from the seatback cover with
pad.
(d) Remove the seatback cover from the seatback pad.
4.
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
REMOVE SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 nuts and side airbag assembly from the seatback
frame.
CAUTION:
Do not store the side airbag assembly with the airbag
deployment direction facing down.
Never disassemble the side airbag assembly.
5.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Remove the 4 bolts and seat cushion assembly from the seat
adjuster.
6.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Remove the seat cushion frame.
(b) Remove the seat cushion cover from the seat cushion
pad.
7.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
(a) Front seat cushion inner No.1 shield
(b) Front seat cushion bracket
(c) Front seat cushion inner shield
Author:
Date:
2443
BO–96
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MX–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
2.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL THESE PARTS:
Front seat cushion inner shield
Front seat cushion bracket
Front seat cushion inner No.1 shield
INSTALL SEAT CUSHION COVER
Install the seat cushion cover to seat cushion pad.
Install the seat cushion cover with pad to the seat cushion
frame.
3.
INSTALL SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Install the seat cushion assembly with 4 bolts to the seat adjuster.
HINT:
Tighten the 4 bolts temporarily, then from the bolts on the rear
side tighten completely.
4.
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
INSTALL SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Install the side airbag assembly with 2 nuts to the seatback
frame.
Torque: 6.0 N·m (61 kgf·cm, 53 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the side airbag assembly is installed
to the specified torque.
If the side airbag assembly has been dropped, or
there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case or
connector, replace the side airbag assembly with a
new one.
When installing the side airbag assembly, take care
is not pinched between other parts.
5.
INSTALL SEATBACK COVER
(a) Install the seatback cover to the seatback pad.
(b) Install the seatback cover with pad to the seatback frame.
(c) Install the headrest supports.
(d)
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Hang the hook on to the seatback frame.
CAUTION:
Take care to hung the hook securely. Otherwise the seat
cove slides, it might cause incorrect deploying.
H01870
Author:
Date:
2444
BO–97
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMMK Made)
6.
INSTALL SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the seatback assembly with 4 bolts.
HINT:
Tighten the 4 bolts temporarily, then from the bolt on the front
right side tighten completely.
(b) Install Front Seatback hinge cover with bolts.
(c) Install a new hog rings.
HINT:
Install the hog rings to prevent wrinkles as least as possible.
(d)
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Securely fix the side airbag wire harness to seat cushion
by clips.
INSTALL THESE PARTS:
Front seat inner belt
Headrest
w/ Lumber Support:
Lumber support lever
Seat cushion lower shield
Front power seat switch
Front seat cushion shield
Switch knob
H01871
Author:
Date:
2445
BO–98
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Power Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MY–01
INSTALLATION
INSTALL FRONT SEAT
(a) Mount the seat to the vehicle.
(b) w/ Side Airbag:
Connect the connector.
(c) Connect the front power seat connector.
(d) Tighten the bolts on the rear side temporarily, from the bolt on the inner side tighten completely.
(e) Slide the seat to the most rear position to install the bolts on the front side.
Author:
Date:
2446
BO–99
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
BO0MZ–01
COMPONENTS
Headrest
Seatback Pad
Hog Ring
Headrest Support
Seatback Cover
Seatback Frame
w/ Side Airbag:
Seat Cushion Cover
6.0 (61, 53 in.·lbf)
Side Airbag
Assembly
18 (185, 13)
Seat Cushion
Pad
Seat Cushion
Inner Shield
Hog Ring
Seat Cushion
Frame
w/ Lumber Support:
Lumper Support Lever
Front Seat Inner Upper Track
Seat Track Adjusting
Handle
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
37 (375, 27)
18 (185, 13)
Seat Track Cover
w/o Vertical:
Front Seat Inner Upper Track
Front Seat
Inner Track
18 (185, 13)
Release
Handle
37 (375, 27)
37 (375, 27)
Front Seat
Inner Track
37 (375, 27)
37 (375, 27)
Front Seat Cushion
Shield
Vertical Adjuster
Knob
Front Seat Cushion
Lower Shield
Release
Handle
Front Seat Outer
Adjuster
Front Seat Cushion
Shield
Front Seat Cushion Lower Shield
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
H01869
Author:
Date:
2447
BO–100
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
BO0N0–01
REMOVAL
REMOVE FRONT SEAT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the seat track outer cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts.
(c) w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Disconnect the connector.
(d) Remove the front seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
Author:
Date:
2448
BO–101
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
BO0N1–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
Release handle
Front seat cushion shield
Vertical Seat Adjuster:
Vertical adjuster knob
Front seat cushion lower shield
Seat cushion inner shield
w/ Lumber Support:
Lumber support lever
Headrest
Front seat inner belt
REMOVE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Remove the side airbag wire harness after removing
clips.
Remove the bolts and seatback assembly.
3.
(a)
(b)
H01870
REMOVE SEATBACK COVER
Remove the hog rings.
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Remove the hook from the seatback frame.
(c) Remove the headrest supports.
(d) Remove the seatback frame from the seatback cover with
pad.
(e) Remove the seatback cover from the seatback pad.
4.
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
REMOVE SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Remove the 1 clip of side airbag wire harness, 2 nuts and side
airbag assembly from the seatback frame.
CAUTION:
Do not store the side airbag assembly with the airbag
deployment direction facing down.
Never disassemble the side airbag assembly.
5.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Remove the 4 bolts and seat cushion assembly from the seat
adjuster.
6.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Remove the seat cushion frame.
(b) Remove the seat cushion cover from the seat cushion
pad.
7.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK ADJUSTING HANDLE
Remove the seat track handle.
8.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER ADJUSTER
Remove the E ring and front seat outer adjuster from the front
seat inner truck with upper track.
Author:
Date:
2449
BO–102
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
BO0N2–01
INSPECTION
INSPECT RECLINING LOCK POSITION AND SLIDING LOCK POSITION SLIPPING OFF
(a) When reclining the seat, inspect that the outer and inner tracks are released at the same time.
HINT:
When the reclining lock positions slip off, disassemble the seat to adjust the position.
(b) When sliding the seat, inspect that the outer and inner tracks are locked at the same time.
HINT:
When sliding lock positions slip off, loosen the bolts to adjust the position.
Author:
Date:
2450
BO–103
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
BO0N3–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
Vertical Seat Adjuster:
INSTALL FRONT SEAT OUTER ADJUSTER
Install front seat outer adjuster to front seat inner adjuster with
E ring, nuts and bolts.
2.
w/o Vertical Seat Adjuster:
INSTALL FRONT SEAT OUTER AND INNER ADJUSTER
Install the adjusters to the seat cushion frame.
3.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK ADJUSTING HANDLE
Install the seat track adjusting handle.
4.
Vertical Seat Adjuster:
INSTALL SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Install the seat cushion cover to seat cushion pad.
(b) Install the seat cushion cover with pad to the seat cushion
frame.
5.
INSTALL SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Install the seat cushion assembly with 4 bolts to the seat adjuster.
HINT:
Tighten the 4 bolts temporarily, then from the bolts on the rear
side tighten completely.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
6.
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
INSTALL SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Install the side airbag assembly with new 2 nuts to the seatback
frame.
Torque: 6.0 N·m (61 kgf·cm, 53 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the side airbag assembly is installed
to the specified torque.
If the side airbag assembly has been dropped, or
there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case or
connector, replace the side airbag assembly with a
new one.
When installing the side airbag assembly, take care
is not pinched between other parts.
7.
INSTALL SEATBACK COVER
(a) Install the seatback cover to the seatback pad.
(b) Install the seatback cover with pad to the seatback frame.
(c) Install the headrest supports.
Author:
Date:
2451
BO–104
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
(d)
H01870
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Hang the hook on to the seatback frame.
CAUTION:
Take care to hung the hook securely. Otherwise the seat
cover slides, it might cause incorrect deploying.
8.
INSTALL SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the seatback assembly with bolts.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
(b) Install new hog rings.
HINT:
Install the hog rings to prevent wrinkles as least as possible.
(c) w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Securely fix the side airbag wire harness to seat cushion
and seatback by clips.
9.
INSTALL THESE PARTS:
(a) Front seat inner belt
(b) Headrest
(c) Lumber support lever
(d) Seat cushion inner shield
(e) Front seat cushion shield
(f)
Vertical Seat Adjuster:
Vertical adjuster knob
(g) Front seat cushion lower shield
(h) Release handle
Author:
Date:
2452
BO–105
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMC Made)
BO0N4–01
INSTALLATION
INSTALL FRONT SEAT
(a) Slide the front seat to the most front position.
NOTICE:
Make sure that seat adjuster locks.
(b) Without holding the seat track handle, mount the seat to the vehicle.
HINT:
If holding the seat track handle, the adjusted most front positions slip off.
(c) Tighten the bolts on the rear side temporarily, from the bolt on the inner side tighten completely.
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
(d) Slide the seat to the most rear position to install the bolts on the front side.
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2453
BO–106
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMMK Made)
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MO–01
COMPONENTS
Front Seatback Pad
Hog Ring
Headrest
Front Seatback Cover
Front Seat Cushion Cover
Headrest
Support
Hog Ring
Front Seatback
Frame
Front Seatback
Hinge Cover
w/ Lumber Support:
Lumber Support Lever
Front Seat
Cushion Pad
Inner Adjuster
Sub–Assembly
Track Cover
Front Seat Cushion
Shield
Front Seat Cushion Frame
Release
Handle
Seat Track
Adjusting Handle
w/o Vertical:
Outer Adjuster
Sub–Assembly
Inner Adjuster
Sub–Assembly
Vertical Adjuster Knob
Front Seat Cushion
Lower Shield
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Side Airbag
Assembly
Outer Adjuster
Sub–Assembly
Front Seat Cushion
Shield
Front Seat Cushion
Lower Shield
Release Handle
6.0 (61, 53 in.·lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
H01872
Author:
Date:
2454
BO–107
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MP–01
REMOVAL
REMOVE FRONT SEAT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the seat track covers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts.
(c) w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Disconnect the connector.
(d) Remove the front seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the body.
Author:
Date:
2455
BO–108
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MQ–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
Release handle
Front seat cushion shield
Vertical Seat Adjuster:
Vertical adjuster knob
Front seat cushion lower shield
Front seatback hinge cover.
w/ Lumber Support:
Lumber support lever
Headrest
Front seat inner belt
REMOVE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Remove the side airbag wire harness after removing
clips.
Remove the hog rings.
Remove the bolts and seatback assembly.
3.
(a)
H01870
REMOVE SEATBACK COVER
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Remove the hook from the seatback frame.
(b) Remove the headrest supports.
(c) Remove the seatback frame from the seatback cover with
pad.
(d) Remove the seatback cover from the seatback pad.
4.
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
REMOVE SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 nuts and side airbag assembly from the seatback
frame.
CAUTION:
Do not store the side airbag assembly with the airbag
deployment direction facing down.
Never disassemble the side airbag assembly.
5.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Remove the 4 bolts and seat cushion assembly from the seat
adjuster.
6.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Remove the seat cushion frame.
(b) Remove the seat cushion cover from the seat cushion
pad.
7.
REMOVE RECLINING CONNECTING PIPE
Remove the reclining connecting pipe.
8.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK ADJUSTING HANDLE
Remove the seat track adjusting handle.
9.
REMOVE OUTER ADJUSTER SUB–ASSEMBLY
Remove the outer adjuster sub–assembly from the inner adjuster sub–assembly.
Author:
Date:
2456
BO–109
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MR–01
INSPECTION
INSPECT RECLINING LOCK POSITION AND SLIDING LOCK POSITION SLIPPING OFF
(a) When reclining the seat, inspect that the outer and inner tracks are released at the same time.
HINT:
When the reclining lock positions slip off, disassemble the seat to adjust the position.
(b) When sliding the seat, inspect that the outer and inner tracks are locked at the same time.
HINT:
When sliding lock positions slip off, loosen the bolts to adjust the position.
Author:
Date:
2457
BO–110
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MS–01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OUTER ADJUSTER SUB–ASSEMBLY
Install the outer adjuster sub–assembly to the inner adjuster
sub–assembly.
2.
INSTALL SEAT ADJUSTING HANDLE
Install the seat track adjusting handle.
3.
INSTALL RECLINING CONNECTING PIPE
(a) Adjust the reclining lock positions of the seat adjusters.
(b) Slide the seat adjusters to the most front position.
(c) Place the adjusters on a spacer to adjust the seat rails in
parallel and install the connecting pipe.
HINT:
When installing the connecting pipe with raising up the adjusters, the lock positions adjusted in 3–(a) step slip off, lock error
will occur.
4.
INSTALL SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Install the seat cushion cover to seat cushion pad.
(b) Install the seat cushion cover with pad to the seat cushion
frame.
5.
INSTALL SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Install the seat cushion assembly with 4 bolts to the seat adjuster.
HINT:
Tighten the 4 bolts temporarily, then from the bolts on the rear
side tighten completely.
6.
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
INSTALL SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Install the side airbag assembly with 2 nuts to the seatback
frame.
Torque: 6.0 N·m (61 kgf·cm, 53 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the side airbag assembly is installed
to the specified torque.
If the side airbag assembly has been dropped, or
there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case or
connector, replace the side airbag assembly with a
new one.
When installing the side airbag assembly, take care
is not pinched between other parts.
7.
INSTALL SEATBACK COVER
(a) Install the seatback cover to the seatback pad.
(b) Install the seatback cover with pad to the seatback frame.
(c) Install the headrest supports.
Author:
Date:
2458
BO–111
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMMK Made)
(d)
H01870
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Hang the hook on to the seatback frame.
CAUTION:
Take care to hung the hook securely. Otherwise the seat
cover slides, it might cause incorrect deploying.
8.
INSTALL SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the seatback assembly with 4 bolts.
HINT:
Tighten the 4 bolts temporarily, then from the bolt on the front
right side tighten completely.
(b) Install a new hog rings.
HINT:
Install the hog rings to prevent wrinkles as least as possible.
(c)
9.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
w/ Side Airbag Assembly:
Securely fix the side airbag wire harness to seat cushion
by clips.
INSTALL THESE PARTS:
Front seat inner belt
Headrest
w/ Lumber Support:
Lumber support lever
Front seatback hinge cover
Front seat cushion lower shield
Vertical Seat Adjuster:
Vertical adjuster knob
Front seat cushion shield
Release handle
H01871
Author:
Date:
2459
BO–112
BODY
–
FRONT SEAT (Manual Seat for TMMK Made)
BO0MT–01
INSTALLATION
INSTALL FRONT SEAT
(a) Slide the front seat to the most front position.
NOTICE:
Make sure that seat adjuster locks.
(b) Without holding the seat track handle, mount the seat to the vehicle.
HINT:
If holding the seat track handle, the adjusted most front positions slip off.
(c) Tighten the bolts on the rear side temporarily, from the bolt on the inner side tighten completely.
(d) Slide the seat to the most rear position to install the bolts on the front side.
Author:
Date:
2460
BO–113
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMC Made)
REAR SEAT (TMC Made)
BO0NA–01
COMPONENTS
Headrest
Seatback Locking Knob
Headrest Support
Seatback Lock Knob Gromet
Seatback Frame
Rear Seatback Lock Control
Seatback Pad
Seatback Lock control Cable
Rear Seatback lock
17.5 (178, 12.5)
Control Bezel
Seatback Cover
Seat Belt Guide
RH Rear Side
Seatback
RH Seatback
Hinge
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
Center Seatback Hinge
Rear Seat center
Armrest
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
Center Armrest
Hinge Cover
LH Rear Side
Seatback
LH Seatback Hinge
Seat Cushion Cover
Seat Cushion Pad
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H01874
Author:
Date:
2461
BO–114
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMC Made)
BO0NB–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE LH SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Release lock to lean the seat back to front.
(b) Remove the clips.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and LH seatback assembly.
2.
REMOVE RH SEAT BACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Release lock to lean the seatback to front.
(b) Remove the clips.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and RH seatback assembly.
3.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the seat cushion assembly.
HINT:
Remove the rear seat inner with center belt from seat cushion slit to remove the seat cushion.
(b) Remove the 2 lock hooks.
4.
REMOVE LH AND RH REAR SIDE SEATBACK
(a) Remove the bolt and LH rear side seatback.
(b) Remove the bolt and RH rear side seatback.
5.
REMOVE SEATBACK HINGE
(a) Remove the bolts and LH seatback hinge and RH seatback hinge.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and center seatback hinge.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2462
BO–115
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMC Made)
BO0NC–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION COVER
Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover from the seat cushion pad.
2.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
HINT:
Remove the clips to turn over the seatback cover before performing the following steps.
(a) Headrest
(b) Rear seatback lock control Bezel.
(c) Rear seatback Board
(d) Headrest supports
(e) Seatback locking knob
(f)
Seatback lock knob Gromet
(g) Rear seat center armrest
3.
REMOVE SEATBACK COVER
(a) Remove the hog rings and seatback frame from the seatback cover with pad.
(b) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover from the seatback pad.
4.
REMOVE SEATBACK LOCK
(a) Remove the rear seatback lock control cable.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and rear seatback lock control.
Torque: 17.5 N·m (178 kgf·cm, 12.5 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2463
BO–116
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMC Made)
BO0ND–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–115).
Author:
Date:
2464
BO–117
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMC Made)
BO0NE–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–114).
Author:
Date:
2465
BO–118
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMMK Made)
REAR SEAT (TMMK Made)
BO0N5–01
COMPONENTS
Seatback Lock Knob
Headrest
Rear seatback Board
Seatback Lock Knob
Cover
Rear Seatback Lock
Control
Headrest
Support
Rear Seatback frame
Rear Seatback Pad
17.5 (178, 12.5)
Rear Seatback Cover
Rear Seatback Lock
Control Cable
RH Rear Side
Seatback
RH Seatback Hinge
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
Center Seatback
Hinge
Rear Seat center
Armrest
Center Armrest
Hinge Cover
w/ CRS:
Rear Seatback
Control Bezel
18 (185, 13)
18 (185, 13)
Headrest
LH Side Seatback
Headrest Suppot
Seatback Pad
Seatback Cover
LH Seatback Hinge
Seat Cushion Cover
7.8 (79, 69 in.·lbf)
42 (428, 31)
Child Restraint
Seat Cover
18 (185, 13)
13 (130, 9)
Child Restraint Seat
Seat Cushion Pad
Center Seatback
Hinge
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H01875
Author:
Date:
2466
BO–119
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMMK Made)
BO0N6–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the seat cushion assembly.
HINT:
Remove the rear seat inner with center belt from seat cushion slit to remove the seat cushion.
(b) Remove the 2 lock hooks.
2.
REMOVE LH SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Release lock to lean the seatback to front.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and LH seatback assembly.
3.
w/ CRS:
REMOVE CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT
(a) Remove child restraint seat cover.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(c) Remove the child restraint seat.
4.
w/o CRS:
REMOVE RH SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Release lock to lean the seatback to front.
(b) Remove the clips.
(c) Remove the bolts and RH seatback assembly.
5.
w/ CRS:
REMOVE RH SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts.
Torque:
RH bolt: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
Center bolt: 42 N·m (428 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
(b) Remove the RH seatback assembly.
6.
REMOVE LH AND RH REAR SIDE SEATBACK
(a) Remove the bolt and LH rear side seatback.
(b) Remove the bolt and RH rear side seatback.
7.
REMOVE SEATBACK HINGE
(a) Remove the bolt and LH seatback hinge.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and center seatback hinge.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
(c) w/o CRS:
Remove the bolt and RH seatback hinge.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2467
BO–120
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMMK Made)
BO0N7–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION COVER
Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover from the seat cushion pad.
2.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
HINT:
Remove the clips to turn over the seatback cover before performing the following steps.
(a) Headrest
(b) Rear seatback control Bezel
(c) Headrest supports
(d) Seatback lock knob
(e) Seatback lock knob cover
(f)
Rear seat center armrest
3.
REMOVE SEATBACK COVER
(a) Remove the hog rings and seatback frame from the seatback cover with pad.
(b) Remove the hog rings and seatback cover from the satback pad.
4.
REMOVE SEATBACK LOCK
(a) Remove the rear seatback lock control cable.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and rear seatback lock control.
Torque: 17.5 N·m (178 kgf·cm, 12.5 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
2468
BO–121
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMMK Made)
BO0N8–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disasssembly (See page BO–120).
Author:
Date:
2469
BO–122
BODY
–
REAR SEAT (TMMK Made)
BO0N9–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–119).
Author:
Date:
2470
BO–123
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT
BO0NF–01
COMPONENTS
Rear Seat
Outer Belt
42 (420, 31)
Center Belt
42 (420, 31)
42 (420, 31)
Rear Seat
Front Seat
Outer Belt
42 (420, 31)
Front Seat
Front Seat Inner
Belt
42 (420, 31)
42 (420, 31)
Rear Seat Inner Belt
7.8 (79, 69 in.·lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H01877
Author:
Date:
2471
BO–124
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
BO0NG–01
INSPECTION
CAUTION:
Replace the seat belt assembly (outer belt, inner belt, bolts,
nuts or sill–bar) if it has been used in a severe impact. The
entire assembly should be replaced even if damage is not
obvious.
1.
All Seat Belt:
RUNNING TEST (IN SAFE AREA)
(a) Fasten the front seat belts.
(b)
BO0632
HINT:
Conduct this test in a safe area. If the belt does not lock, remove
the belt mechanism assembly and conduct the following static
check. Also, whenever installing a new belt assembly, verify the
proper operation before installation.
2.
Driver’s Seat Belt (ELR):
STATIC TEST
(a) Make sure that the belt locks when pulled out quickly.
(b) Remove the locking retractor assembly.
(c) Tilt the retractor slowly.
(d)
15°
45°
If a
3.
BO0633
Drive the car at 10 mph (16 km/h) and slam on the brakes.
Check that the belt locks and cannot be extended at this
time.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
If a
Make sure that the belt can be pulled out at a tilt of 15 degrees or less, and cannot be pulled out over 45 degrees
of tilt.
problem is found, replace the assembly.
Front RH Seat Belt and Rear Seat Belt (ALR/ELR):
STATIC TEST
Make sure that the belt locks when pulled out quickly.
Remove the locking retractor assembly.
Pull out the whole belt and measure the length of the
whole belt.
Then retract the belt slightly and pull it out again
Make sure that the belt cannot be extended further.
problem is found, replace the assembly.
Author:
Date:
2472
BO–125
BODY
(e)
(f)
–
SEAT BELT
Retract the whole belt, then pull out the belt until 200 mm
(7.87 in.) of belt remains retracted.
Tilt the retractor slowly.
Full Belt Length Minus
200 mm (7.87 in.)
N10070
(g)
Make sure that the belt can be pulled out at a tilt of 15 degrees or less, and cannot be pulled out at over 45 degrees
of tilt.
If a problem is found, replace the assembly.
15°
45°
BO0633
Author:
Date:
2473
BO–126
BODY
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
BO0NH–01
REMOVAL
NOTICE:
If the wiring connector of the supplemental restraint
system is disconnected with the ignition switch at ON
or ACC, diagnostic trouble codes will be recorded.
Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
1.
REMOVE THESE PARTS:
(a) Front door scuff plate
(b) Center pillar lower garnish
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
CAUTION:
Never disassemble the front seat outer belt.
NOTICE:
When removing the front outer seat belt, take care not to
pull the seat belt pretensioner wire harness.
(a) Remove the bolts and floor anchor.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the anchor caps.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Remove the bolt and shoulder anchor.
(d)
(e)
Disconnect the pretensioner connector as shown in the
illustration.
Remove the 2 bolts and front seat outer belt.
H01346
Author:
Date:
2474
BO–127
BODY
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
BO0NI–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
PRETENSIONER IS NOT ACTIVATED
Perform a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
H00563
(b)
H01878
Perform a visual check which includes the following items
with the front seat outer belt removed from the vehicle.
Check for cuts and cracks in, or marked discoloration of the center pillar lower garnish.
Check for cuts and cracks in wire harnesses, and for
chipping in connectors.
Check for deformation of the center pillar.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the front seat outer belt, see
page BO–123.
Be sure to follow the correct procedure.
2.
PRETENSIONER IS ACTIVATED
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check.
(See page DI–626)
(b) Perform a visual check which includes the following items
with the front seat outer belt removed from the vehicle.
Check for deformation of the center pillar.
Check for damage on the connector and wire harness.
Author:
Date:
2475
BO–128
BODY
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
BO0NJ–01
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping vehicles equipped with a supplemental restraint system or disposing of a front seat outer belt (with seat
belt pretensioner) always first activate the seat belt pretensioner in accordance with the procedure described below. If any abnormality occurs with the seat belt pretensioner operation, contact the SERVICE DEPT. of the DISTRIBUTOR. when
disposing of a front seat outer belt (with seat belt pretensioner)
deployed in a collision, follow the same procedure given in step
1–(d) in ”DISPOSAL”.
SST
AB0152
CAUTION:
Never dispose of front seat outer belt which has an
undeployed pretensioner.
The seat belt pretensioner produces a sizeable exploding sound when it deploys, so perform the operation out–of–door and where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
When deploying the seat belt pretensioner, always
use the specified SST. (SRS Airbag Deployment Tool)
Perform the operation in a place away from electrical
noise.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00740
When deploying a front seat outer belt (with seat belt
pretensioner), perform the operation from at least
10 m (33 ft) away from the front seat outer belt.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat outer belt with operated pretensioner.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat outer belt with
operated pretensioner.
Author:
Date:
2476
BO–129
BODY
1.
Battery
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER DEPLOYMENT WHEN
SCRAPPING VEHICLE
HINT:
Have a battery ready as the power source to deploy the airbag.
SST
AB0158
(a) Check functioning of SST
CAUTION:
When deploying the seat belt pretensioner, always use the
specified SST: SRS Airbag Deployment Tool.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00740
SST
AB0152
(1)
Battery
Connect the SST to battery.
Connect the red clip of the SST to the battery positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the battery negative (–) terminal.
HINT:
Do not connect the yellow connector which will be connected
with the seat belt pretensioner.
SST
AB0158
(2)
SST
H01580
Check functioning of SST
Press the SST activation switch, and check the LED
of the SST activation switch lights up.
CAUTION:
If the LED lights up when the activation switch is not being
pressed, SST malfunction is probable, so definitely do not
use the SST.
(b) Install the SST.
(1) Remove the front door scuff plate.
(2) Remove the center pillar lower garnish.
(3) Disconnect the pretensioner connector as shown in
the illustration.
(4) Buckle the front seat belt and check that there is no
looseness and slack in the front seat inner belt and
front seat outer belt.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00740
H01346
Author:
Date:
2477
BO–130
BODY
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
(5)
SST
Connect the 2 SST, then connect them to the seat
belt pretensioner.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00740
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of secondary lock of the
twin lock.
SST
H01880
(6)
10 m (33 ft) or more
R13455
Move the SST to at least 10mm (33 ft) from the front
of the vehicle.
Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
(7)
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
(8) Connect the SST red clip the battery positive (–) terminal and the black clip to the negative (+) terminal.
(c) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Confirm that no one is inside the vehicle or within 10
m (33 ft) area around of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and activate the
seat belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner operates simultaneously as the LED
of the SST activation switch light up.
(d) Disposal of front seat outer belt (with seat belt pretensioner).
CAUTION:
The front seat outer belt is very hot when the seat belt
pretensioner is deployed, so leave it alone for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat outer belt with deployed seat belt pretensioner.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat outer belt with
deployed seat belt pretensioner.
When scrapping a vehicle, activate the seat belt pretensioner and scrap the vehicle with operated front seat outer belt still installed.
Author:
Date:
2478
BO–131
BODY
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
2.
DEPLOYMENT WHEN DISPOSING OF FRONT SEAT
OUTER BELT ONLY
NOTICE:
When disposing of the front seat outer belt (with seat
belt pretensioner) only, never use the customer’s vehicle to deploy the seat belt pretensioner.
Be sure to following the procedure given below when
deploying the seat belt pretensioner.
HINT:
Have a battery ready as the power source when deploying the
seat belt pretensioner.
(a) Remove the front seat outer belt
(See page BO–123)
HINT:
Cut the belt near the seat belt retractor.
(b)
Check functioning of SST.
(See step 1–(a))
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00740
Battery
SST
AB0158
(c)
SST
Install the SST.
(1) Connect the 2 SST, then connect them to the seat
belt pretensioner.
SST 09082–00700, 09082–00740
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and wire harness,
do not lock the secondary lock of the twin lock.
SST
H01880
(2)
SST
Locate the front seat outer belt on the ground and
cover it by the disc wheel with tire.
NOTICE:
Place the front seat outer belt shown in the illustration.
(3) Move the SST to as least 10 m (33 ft) from the disc
wheel.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire harness.
SST
H01881
Author:
Date:
2479
BO–132
BODY
(d)
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
Deploy the seat belt pretensioner.
(1) Connect the SST red clip to the battery positive (+)
terminal and black clip to the battery negative (–)
terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within 10 m (33 ft) area around
of the disc wheel.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and activate the
seat belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner operates simultaneously as the LED
of the SST activation switch lights up.
10 m (33 ft) or more
R05181
(e)
H01882
Disposal of front seat outer belt (with seat belt pretensioner).
CAUTION:
The front seat outer belt is very hot when the seat belt
pretensioner is deployed, so leave it alone for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat outer belt with deployed seat belt pretensioner.
Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
Do not apply water, etc. to a front seat outer belt with
deployed seat belt pretensioner.
(1) Remove the disc wheel and SST.
(2) Place the front seat outer belt in a vinyl bag, tie the
end tightly and dispose of in it the same way as other general parts.
Author:
Date:
2480
BO–133
BODY
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
BO0NK–01
REPLACEMENT
REPLACE REQUIREMENTS
In the following cases, replace the seat belt pretensioner.
If the seat belt pretensioner has been activated.
If the seat belt pretensioner has been found to be faulty in troubleshooting.
If the front seat outer belt has been found to be faulty during the check in items 1–(b) or 2–(b).
If the front seat outer belt has been dropped.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the seat belt pretensioner, see page BO–126 and BO–134.
Be sure to follow the correct procedure.
Author:
Date:
2481
BO–134
BODY
–
SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
BO0NL–01
INSTALLATION
NOTICE:
Never use seat belt pretensioner from another vehicle.
When replace parts, replace them with new parts.
1.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
(a) Install the front seat belt parts by following the reverse order of removal and torque the following bolts.
(1) Front seat outer belt retractor
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
(2) Seat belt shoulder anchor
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
(3) Seat belt floor anchor
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the front seat outer belt is installed
with the specified torque.
If the front seat outer belt has been dropped, or there
are cracks, dents or other defects in the case or connector, replace the front seat outer belt with a new
one.
When installing the front seat outer belt, take care that
the wiring does not interfere with other parts and is
not pinched between other parts.
(b)
(c)
2.
(a)
(b)
Connect the pretensioner connector as shown in the illustration.
w/ Seat Belt Warning:
Connect the retractor switch connector.
INSTALL THESE PARTS:
Center pillar lower garnish
Front door scuff plate
H01352
Author:
Date:
2482
BE–1
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
BE16T–01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
COMBINATION METER
METER, GAUGES AND ILLUMINATION:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Tachometer, Fuel Gauge and Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
do not operate.
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–4
–
Fuel Gauge does not operate or abnormal operation.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Fuel Receiver Gauge
Fuel Temperature Sensor (For Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Temperature Sensor (For Fuel Tank)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (For Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (For Fuel Pipe)
ECM
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
BE–5
SF–36
SF–40
SF–42
SF–45
–
BE–4
–
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge does not operate or abnormal
operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
Engine Coolant Temperature Receiver Gauge
Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Gauge
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
BE–5
BE–5
BE–4
–
All illumination lights do not light up.
1. TAIL Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Light Control Rheostat
3. Wire Harness
Only one illumination light does not light up.
1. Bulb
2. Wire Harness
–
BE–54*
–
–
–
COMBINATION METER
WARNING LIGHTS:
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
Warning lights do not light up. (Except Discharge, Open Door and
SRS)
1. GAUGE Fuse (I/P J/B No.1)
2. Meter Circuit Plate
3. Wire Harness
–
BE–4
–
Low Oil Pressure warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bulb
Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
BE–5
BE–4
–
Fuel Level warning light does not light up.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Bulb
Fuel Temperature Sensor (For Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Temperature Sensor (For Fuel Tank)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (For Delivery Pipe)
Fuel Pressure Sensor (For Fuel Pipe)
ECM
Meter Circuit Plate
Wire Harness
–
SF–36
SF–40
SF–42
SF–45
–
BE–4
–
*: See Pub. No. RM654U
Author:
Date:
533
BE–2
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
COMBINATION METER
BE0AI–04
LOCATION
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
E/G Room J/B No.2
ECU–B Fuse
DOME Fuse
Washer Fluid Level
Warning Switch
Combination Meter
Bulb Check Relay
ECM
ABS ECU
Light Control Rheostat
Instrument Panel J/B No.1
GAUGE Fuse
TAIL Fuse
IGN Fuse
Integration Relay
I08447
Author:
Date:
534
BE–3
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
Door Courtesy Switch
PKB Switch
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Door Courtesy Switch
Light Failure Sensor
Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Engine Coolant Temperature
Sender Gauge
Park/Neutral Position Switch
I08448
Author:
Date:
535
BE–4
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
BE0AJ–04
CIRCUIT
Connector ”A”
1 2 3 4 5 6
Connector ”B”
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
7 8 9 10 11 12 13
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
J–13–1–A
C7
E
T
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 1213
J–16–1
B3
C5
A2
A1
C8
F
Connector ”C”
Connector ”C”
Connector ”B”
J–13–1
Connector ”A”
B15
C6
S
B14
ODOMETER
Fuel Level Warning
Seat Belt Warning
ABS Warning
Low Oil Pressure Warning
Cruise Control Indicator
Malfunction Indicator
O/D OFF Indicator
Light Failure Warning
Brake Warning
SLIP Indicator
TRAC Indicator
Washer Level Warning
Discharge Warning
A13
B2
C1
B1
C9
A6
A11
A7
A10
A8
A9
Bulb Check
Relay
Right Turn Indicator
Left Turn Indicator
Security Indicator
L
2
D
N
R
P
Illumination
C13
B8
B11
B12
Hi–Beam Indicator
Open Door Warning
SRS Warning
B6
A4
C4
B5
C10
C2
A12
A3
B7
C3
A5
C11
B4
No.
A
B16
B
C12
B9
B10
B13
C
F : Fuel Gauge
E : Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Gauge
T : Tachometer
S : Speedometer
N20107 N20108
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Wire Harness Side
Engine coolant temperature sender gauge
Ground
Light failure sensor
Integration relay
Traction ECU
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
Park/neutral position switch (A/T)
O/D OFF switch (A/T)
IGN fuse
Turn signal switch
ST relay
ECM
Generator
Oil pressure switch
ECM
Parking brake switch and brake fluid level warning switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Headlight dimmer switch
Door courtesy switch
DOME fuse
ECU–B fuse
Airbag sensor assembly
ECM
No.1 Vehicle speed sensor
Ground
Turn signal switch
ECM
Traction ECU
ABS ECU
Ground
No.1 Vehicle speed sensor
GAUGE fuse
Igniter
Security ECU
Cruise control ECU
Washer fluid level warning switch
Light control rheostat
TAIL fuse
Z18937
BE–5
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
BE16U–01
INSPECTION
Ignition
Switch
Fuel
Gauge
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the ECM.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the receiver gauge
needle indicates EMPTY.
(c)
Connect terminals 2 on the wire harness side connector
through a 3.4–W test bulb.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the bulb lights up
and the receiver gauge needle moves towards the full
side.
ECM
Battery
I12031
Fuel Gauge
(d)
Ignition
Switch Wire Harness Side
Battery
I12029
HINT:
Because of the silicon oil in the gauge, it will take a short time
for needle to stabilize.
If operation is not as specified, inspect the receiver gauge resistance.
2.
INSPECT FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
A
B
C
N20212
Ignition
Switch
Wire Harness Side
Battery
I12030
Resistance (Ω)
A–B
Approx. 270.1
A–C
Approx. 141.3
B–C
Approx. 128.8
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver
gauge.
3.
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
(See page SF–36)
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Warning Light
Tester connection
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Connect terminals 8 on the wire harness side connector.
Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the warning light
lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb or inspect wire
harness.
5.
INSPECT FUEL LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(See page SF–40)
BE–6
BODY ELECTRICAL
6.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
(a)
(b)
Ignition
Switch
Sender
Gauge
Battery
–
COMBINATION METER
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the receiver
gauge needle indicates COOL.
N20215
(c)
Ground terminal on the wire harness side connector
through a 3.4–W test bulb.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON, and check that the bulb lights
up and the receiver gauge needle moves to the hot side.
If operation is as specified, replace the sender gauge.
Then, recheck the system.
If operation is not as specified, measure the receiver gauge resistance.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
Ignition
Switch
Battery
Test Bulb
(3.4 W)
Wire Harness Side
Z15788
7.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
C
B
A
N20216
Tester connection
Resistance (Ω) *
A–B
Approx. 175.7
A–C
Approx. 54.0
B–C
Approx. 229.7
*: This circuit includes the diode.
HINT:
Connect the test leads so that the current from the ohmmeter
can flow according to the above order.
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver
gauge.
BE–7
BODY ELECTRICAL
–
COMBINATION METER
8.
35.63 ±
0.1 Ω
35.63 ±
Slide
rheostat 0.1 Ω
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Connect the wire harness as shown in the illustration, and adjust the ammeter pointer to indicate ”0” using the slide rheostat,
then read the rheostat indication.
Temperature °C (°F)
Resistance (Ω)
50 (122.0)
160 – 240
120 (248.0)
17.1 – 21.2
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the engine coolant temperature sender gauge.
I07709
9.
(a)
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
Disconnect the connector from the warning switch and
ground terminal on the wire harness side connector.
(b) Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the warning
light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Warning Light
Ignition
Switch
Battery
1
Z14205
10.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N06640
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Disconnect the connector from the switch.
Check that continuity exists between terminal and ground
with the engine stopped.
Check that no continuity exists between terminal and
ground with the engine running.
HINT:
Oil pressure should be over 24.5 kPa (0.25 kgf/cm2, 3.55 psi).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
BO–1
BODY
–
CLIP
CLIP
BO2DL–01
REPLACEMENT
The removal and installation methods of typical clips used in body parts are shown in the table below.
HINT:
If the clip is damaged during the operation, always replace it with a new clip.
Shape (Example)
Removal/Installation
Pliers
Clip Remover
Screwdriver
Scraper
V00005
Author:
Date:
540
BO–2
BODY
Shape (Example)
–
CLIP
Removal/Installation
Removal
Removal
Installation
Installation
V00012
Author:
Date:
541
BO–3
BODY
–
SRS AIRBAG
SRS AIRBAG
BO2DM–01
PRECAUTION
The CAMRY CNG is equipped with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the driver airbag, front
passenger airbag and seat belt pretensioner. Failure to carry out service operation in the correct sequence
could cause the SRS to unexpectedly deploy during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident. Before
servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the precautionary notices in the RS section (See Pub. No. RM654U).
Author:
Date:
542
BO–4
BODY
–
REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
BO2DN–01
COMPONENTS
Luggage Compartment
Trim Front Cover
Inner Luggage Compartment
Trim Cover
Inner Luggage Compartment
Trim Cover
Spare Wheel Cover
Rear Bumper Reinforcement
Rear Bumper Energy Absorber
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
34 (350, 25)
Rear Bumper
Side Retainer
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Quarter Air Duct
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
Rear Bumper
Side Retainer
Rear Bumper Cover
4.9 (50, 43 in.·lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified Torque
H09249
Author:
Date:
543
BO–5
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO2DO–02
COMPONENTS
Luggage Compartment
Door Hinge
Luggage Compartment Door
5.4 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
Luggage Compartment
Door Hinge
7.8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
7.8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
Door Lock Cylinder
Reat Combination Light
Luggage Compartment Door Cover
x11
Door Lock
22 (224, 16)
Door Lock Striker
5.4 (55, 49 in.·lbf)
22 (224, 16)
22 (224, 16)
Door Support
Spare Wheel Cover
Spare Wheel
Carrier
Spare Wheel
Carrier Spacer
Inner Luggage Compartment
Trim Cover
Luggage Compartment
Trim Front Cover
Spare Wheel
Rear Floor Finish
Side Plate
Rear Floor
Finish Plate
High–mounted
Stop Light
Rear Floor Finish
Side Plate
Rear Seat Outer Belt
Inner Lower Luggage
Compartment Trim Cover
41 (420, 31)
Rear Seat Outer Belt
Rear Seatback
18 (185, 13)
41 (420, 31)
Roof Side
Inner Garnish
Package Tray Trim
Rear Seat Cushion
Roof Side
Inner Garnish
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified Torque
No. 1 Upper Back Panel Hole Cover
Author:
Date:
H09250
544
BO–6
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO2DP–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR COVER
Remove the 11 clips and luggage compartment door cover.
2.
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Using a clip remover, disconnect the clamps.
(c) Remove the 4 bolts and door.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
3.
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT TRIM FRONT
COVER
Using a clip remover, remove the 6 clips and luggage compartment trim front cover.
4.
REMOVE SPARE WHEEL COVER
H09251
5.
H09252
REMOVE INNER LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT TRIM
COVER
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips and inner luggage compartment trim cover.
(b) Employ the same manner described above to the other
side.
6.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH SIDE PLATES
Using a clip remover, remove the 6 clips and 2 rear floor finish
side plates.
7.
REMOVE INNER LOWER LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
TRIM COVER
(a) Remove the spare wheel carrier, spare wheel carrier
spacer and spare wheel.
(b) Using a clip remover, remove the 3 clips and inner lower
luggage compartment trim cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
BO–7
BODY
2 Clips
H09253
3 Clips
Clip
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
8.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR FINISH PLATE
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Insert a screwdriver between the rear floor finish plate and
body to pry out the rear floor finish plate.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
9.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION AND SEATBACK
(See page BO–22)
10. REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
(b) Insert a screwdriver between the roof side inner garnish
and body to pry it out.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Employ the same manner described above to the other
side.
H09254
2
1
1
H09255
1
2
H07599
11. REMOVE HIGH–MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
Remove the high–mounted stop light as shown in the illustration, then disconnect the connector.
12. REMOVE PACKAGE TRAY TRIM
(a) Remove the bolts and rear seat outer belt floor anchors.
Torque: 41 N·m (420 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the seat belt bezels from the
package tray trim.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Using a hexagon wrench, remove the 2 hexagon screws.
(d) Remove the package tray trim, then disconnect the connectors.
HINT:
Remove the package tray trim through out the rear seat outer
belt floor anchors from the hole in the package tray trim.
13. REMOVE NO. 1 UPPER BACK PANEL HOLE COVER
Remove the 2 clips and No. 1 upper back panel hole cover.
14. REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUPPORTS
Remove the 4 bolts and luggage compartment door support.
Torque: 22 N·m (224 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
15. REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR HINGES
Remove the pins and luggage compartment door hinges.
BO–8
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO2DQ–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE DOOR LOCK
Disconnect the control link.
Remove the 2 bolts and door lock.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
2.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LIGHTS
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 6 nuts and rear combination lights.
3.
REMOVE DOOR LOCK CYLINDER
Remove the 2 bolts and door lock cylinder.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
BO–9
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO2DR–01
ADJUSTMENT
1.
(a)
ADJUST LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR
Remove the 11 clips and luggage compartment door cover.
(b)
Loosen the bolts to adjust the lggage compartment door
in forward/rearward and left/right directions.
Tighten the loosened bolts again.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
Increase or decrease the number of washers between the
hinge and door panel to adjust vertical direction.
(c)
(d)
H09256
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
N21779
ADJUST DOOR LOCK STRIKER
Remove the rear floor finish side plates.
Remove the rear floor finish plate.
Loosen the 2 lock striker set bolts.
Using a hammer and brass bar, tap the striker to adjust it.
Tighten the loosened bolts again.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 49 in.·lbf)
BO–10
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO2DS–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–8).
BO–11
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR AND HINGE
BO2DT–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–6).
BO–12
BODY
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUPPORT
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR
SUPPORT
BO2DU–01
REPLACEMENT
1.
H09251
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT TRIM FRONT
COVER
Using a clip remover, remove the 6 clips and luggage compartment trim front cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUPPORT
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and luggage compartment door support from the luggage compartment door panel.
HINT:
While supporting the door with your hand, remove the support.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and support from the body.
3.
IF NECESSARY, REPLACE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUPPORT
NOTICE:
When handling the luggage compartment door support.
Do not disassemble the luggage compartment door
support because the cylinder is filled with pressurized gas.
Hole Here
150 mm (5.91 in.)
H11085
4.
(a)
If the luggage compartment door support is to be replaced, drill a 2.0 – 3.0 mm (0.079 – 0.118 in.) hole in
the bottom of the luggage compartment door support
as shown in the illustration to completely release the
high–pressure gas before disposing of it.
When drilling, chips may fly out so work carefully.
The gas is colorless, odorless and non–toxic.
When working, handle the luggage compartment
door support carefully. Never score or scratch the exposed part of the piston rod, and never allow paint or
oil to get on it.
Do not turn the piston rod and cylinder with the luggage compartment door support fully extended.
INSTALL LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUPPORT
Install the bolt and luggage compartment door support to
the body.
Torque: 22 N·m (224 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
551
BO–13
BODY
(b)
5.
–
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT DOOR SUPPORT
Install the 2 bolts and luggage compartment door support
to the luggage compartment door panel.
Torque: 22 N·m (224 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
INSTALL LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT TRIM FRONT
COVER
Author:
Date:
552
BO–14
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BO2E2–01
COMPONENTS
Stopper
Back Window Outside Moulding
Back Window Glass
Roof Side Inner Garnish
Roof Side Inner Garnish
Rear Seatback
18 (185, 13)
RH Rear Seat Outer Belt
High–mounted Stop Light
LH Rear Seat
Outer Belt
Rear Seat Cushion
41 (420, 30)
Package Tray Trim
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified Torque
Non–reusable part
H09257
Author:
Date:
553
BO–15
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BO2E3–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION AND SEATBACK
(See page BO–22)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
Insert a screwdriver between the roof side inner garnish
and body to pry it out.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Employ the same manner described above to the other
side.
3 Clips
Clip
H09254
3.
REMOVE HIGH–MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
Remove the high–mounted stop light as shown in the illustration, then disconnect the connector.
4.
REMOVE PACKAGE TRAY TRIM
(a) Remove the bolts and rear seat belt floor anchors.
2
1
1
H09255
(b)
1
2
H07599
N20985
Using a screwdriver, remove the seat belt bezels from the
package tray trim.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Using a hexagon wrench, remove the 2 hexagon screws.
(d) Remove the package tray trim, then disconnect the connectors.
HINT:
Remove the package tray trim through out the rear seat outer
belt floor anchors from the hole in the package tray trim.
5.
REMOVE BACK WINDOW OUTSIDE MOULDING
(a) Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the body with the knife.
(b) Remove the remaining moulding.
BO–16
BODY
Protective
Tape
H09266
Protective
Tape
H09258
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
6.
REMOVE BACK WINDOW GLASS
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Push piano wire through from the interior.
(c) Tie both wire ends to wooden blocks or similar objects.
HINT:
Apply protective tape to the outer surface to keep the surface
from being scratched.
NOTICE:
When separating the glass, take care not to damage the
paint and exterior.
(d) Cut the adhesive by pulling the piano wire with leaving the
adhesive where the stoppers are.
NOTICE:
Leave as much of the adhesive on the body as possible
when cutting off the glass.
(e) Remove the glass.
BO–17
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
BO2E4–01
INSTALLATION
Adhesive
BO4420
1.
CLEAN AND SHAPE CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY
(a) Using a knife, cut away any rough areas on the body.
HINT:
Leave as much of the adhesive on the body as possible.
(b) Clean the cutting surface of the adhesive with a piece of
shop rag saturated in cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed, clean the body.
2.
(a)
(b)
CLEAN REMOVED GLASS
Remove the damaged stoppers.
Using a scraper, remove the adhesive sticking to the
glass.
(c) Clean the glass with cleaner.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the glass.
Do not touch the glass face after cleaning it.
BO5231
3.
INSTALL NEW STOPPERS
Attach new stoppers to the ceramic notch areas on the glass to
set stoppers.
H09259
A
H09260
4.
INSTALL NEW BACK WINDOW OUTSIDE MOULDING
Install a new back window outside moulding to the glass as
shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Install the back window outside moulding from the center
of glass at the lower side of vehicle mark A indicates the
ceramic notch for moulding installation.
When installing the back window outside moulding, do
not stretch it.
5.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
H09261
POSITION GLASS
Place the glass in the correct position.
Check that all contacting parts of the glass rim are perfectly even.
Place reference marks on the glass and body.
Remove the glass.
BO–18
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
6.
CLEAN CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS
Using a cleaner, clean the contact surface which is black–colored area around the entire glass rim.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning it.
BO4421
7.
COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF BODY WITH PRIMER
”M”
Using a brush, coat Primer M to the exposed part of body on the
vehicle side.
NOTICE:
Let the coated primer dry for 3 minutes or more.
Do not coat Primer M to the adhesive.
Do not keep any of the opened Primer M for later use.
Primer M
Primer M
Adhesive
H02865
8.
a
a
b
b
b
b
a–a
b–b
Primer G
H09262
COAT CONTACT SURFACE OF GLASS WITH PRIMER
”G”
(a) Using a brush or sponge, coat the contact surface with
Primer G as shown in the illustration.
(b) When the primer is coated wrongly to the area other than
the specified, wipe it off with a clean shop rag before primer dries.
NOTICE:
Let the primer coating dry for 3 minutes or more.
Do not keep any of the opened Primer G for later use.
BO–19
BODY
9.
(a)
a
a
b
b
b–b
a–a
A
B
BACK WINDOW GLASS
APPLY ADHESIVE
Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle.
Part No. 08850–00801 or equivalent
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within the time described in the table below.
b
b
–
Temperature
Tackfree time
35 °C (95 °F)
15 minutes
20 °C (68 °F)
100 minutes
5 °C (41 °F)
8 hour
(b)
(c)
Load the cartridge into the sealer gun.
Apply adhesive to the glass as shown in the illustration.
A: 12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
B: 8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
10.
(a)
INSTALL GLASS
Position the glass so that the reference marks are lined
up, and press in gently along the rim.
A
B
: Adhesive
H09263
H09264
HINT:
Confirm that the moulding is attached to the body panel as
shown in the illustration.
(b) Hold the back window glass in place securely with a protective tape or equivalent until the adhesive hardens.
NOTICE:
Take care not to drive the vehicle during the time described
in the table below.
H09265
11.
(a)
(b)
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving the vehicle
35 °C (95 °F)
1.5 hours
20 °C (68 °F)
5 hours
5 °C (41 °F)
24 hours
INSPECT FOR LEAK AND REPAIR
Conduct a leak test after the hardening time has elapsed.
Seal any leak with sealant.
Part No. 08833–00030 or equivalent
12. INSTALL REAR SIDE OF ROOF HEADLINING
Install the rear side of roof headlining with the 2 clips.
13. INSTALL ASSIST GRIPS
BO–20
BODY
–
BACK WINDOW GLASS
14. INSTALL PACKAGE TRAY TRIM
(a) Connect the connectors.
(b) Install the package tray trim with the 2 screws.
HINT:
Before installing the package tray trim pass the rear seat outer
belt floor anchor through the hole in the package tray trim.
15. INSTALL HIGH–MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
16.
(a)
(b)
17.
3 Clips
Clip
H09254
INSTALL ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
Install the roof side inner garnish with clip.
Employ the same manner described above to the other
side.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION AND SEATBACK
(See page BO–25)
BO–21
BODY
–
REAR SEAT
REAR SEAT
BO2DV–02
COMPONENTS
Headrest
Headrest
Headrest Support
Headrest Support
Rear Seatback Pad
Rear Seatback Cover
18 (185, 13)
Rear Seat Cushion Cover
Hog Ring
Hog Ring
18 (185, 13)
Rear Seat Cushion Cover
Hook
Hook
Rear Seat Cushion Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H09268
Author:
Date:
560
BO–22
BODY
–
REAR SEAT
BO2DW–01
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
Pull up the front part of seat cushion assembly to remove the rear seat cushion assembly.
HINT:
When removing the rear seat cushion assembly, pass the rear seat inner with center belt through the hole
on the seatback.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts.
Torque: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following item. When installing hog rings, take care to prevent
wrinkles as little as possible.
(b) Pull up the seatback assembly to remove it.
BO–23
BODY
–
REAR SEAT
BO2DX–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE HEADRESTS AND HEADREST SUPPORTS
2.
REMOVE SEATBACK COVER
Remove the hog rings and seatback cover from the seatback pad.
3.
REMOVE SEAT CUSHION COVER
Remove the hog rings and seat cushion cover from the seat cushion pad.
BO–24
BODY
–
REAR SEAT
BO2DY–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page BO–23).
BO–25
BODY
–
REAR SEAT
BO2DZ–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page BO–22).
BO–26
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT
BO2E0–01
COMPONENTS
41 (420, 31)
41 (420, 30)
Anchor Cover Cap
41 (420, 30)
Front Seat Outer Belt
Rear Seat Outer Belt
41 (420, 31)
41 (420, 30)
41 (420, 30)
Front Seat
7.8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
41 (420, 30)
RH Rear Seat Inner
with Center Belt
41 (420, 30)
LH Rear Seat Inner
with Center Belt
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
H09269
Author:
Date:
565
BO–27
BODY
–
SEAT BELT
BO2E1–01
INSPECTION
CAUTION:
Replace the seat belt assembly (Outer belt, inner belt,
bolts, nuts or sill–bar) if it has been used in a severe impact. The entire assembly should be replaced even if damage is not obvious.
1.
All seat belt:
RUNNING TEST IN SAFE AREA
(a) Fasten the front seat belts.
(b)
BO0632
HINT:
Conduct this test in a safe area. If the belt does not lock, remove
the belt mechanism assembly and conduct the following static
check. Also whenever installing a new belt assembly, verify the
proper operation before installation.
2.
Driver’s seat belt (ELR):
STATIC TEST
(a) Make sure that the belt locks when pulled out quickly.
(b) Remove the locking retractor assembly.
(c) Tilt the retractor slowly.
(d)
15°
45°
If a
3.
BO0633
Drive the car at 10 m/h (16 km/h) and slam on the brakes.
Check that the belt locks and cannot be extended at this
time.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
If a
Make sure that the belt can be pulled out at a tilt of 15 degrees or less, and cannot be pulled out over 45 degrees
of tilt.
problem is found, replace the assembly.
Except driver’s seat belt (ALR/ELR):
STATIC TEST
Make sure that the belt locks when pulled out quickly.
Remove the locking retractor assembly.
Pull out the whole belt and measure the length of the
whole belt. Then retract the belt slightly and pull it out
again.
Make sure that the belt cannot be extended further.
problem is found, replace the assembly.
BO–28
BODY
(e)
Full Belt Length Minus
200 mm (7.87 in.)
(f)
–
SEAT BELT
Retract the whole belt, then pull out the belt until 200 mm
(7.87 in.) of belt remains retracted.
Tilt the belt slowly.
N10070
(g)
Make sure that the belt can be pulled out at a tilt of 15 degrees or less, and cannot be pulled out at over 45 degrees
of tilt.
If a problem is found, replace the assembly.
15°
45°
BO0633
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
BO5906
Manual type:
TESTING
Adjust the belt to the proper length.
Apply a firm load to the belt.
Make sure that the belt is not extended.
MA–1
MAINTENANCE
–
OUTSIDE VEHICLE
OUTSIDE VEHICLE
MA001–10
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
These are maintenance and inspection items which are considered to be the owner’s responsibility.
They can be done by the owner or they can have them done at a service shop.
These items include those which should be checked on a daily basis, those which, in most cases, do not
require (special) tools and those which are considered to be reasonable for the owner to do.
Items and procedures for general maintenance are as follows.
1.
GENERAL NOTES
Maintenance items may vary from country to country. Check the owner’s manual supplement in which
the maintenance schedule is shown.
Every service item in the periodic maintenance schedule must be performed.
Periodic maintenance service must be performed according to whichever interval in the periodic maintenance schedule occurs first, the odometer reading (miles) or the time interval (months).
Maintenance service after the last period should be performed at the same interval as before unless
otherwise noted.
Failure to do even one item an cause the engine to run poorly and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
TIRES
(a) Check the pressure with a gauge. If necessary, adjust.
(b) Check for cuts, damage or excessive wear.
3.
WHEEL NUTS
When checking the tires, check the nuts for looseness or for missing nuts. If necessary, tighten them.
4.
TIRE ROTATION
Check the owner’s manual supplement in which the maintenance schedule is shown.
5.
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
Check for wear or cracks whenever they do not wipe clean. If necessary, replace.
6.
FLUID LEAKS
(a) Check underneath for leaking fuel, oil, water or other fluid.
(b) If you smell gasoline fumes or notice any leak, have the cause found and corrected.
7.
DOORS AND ENGINE HOOD
(a) Check that all doors and the tailgate operate smoothly, and that all latches lock securely.
(b) Check that the engine hood secondary latch secures the hood from opening when the primary latch
is released.
Author:
Date:
44
MA–2
MAINTENANCE
–
INSIDE VEHICLE
INSIDE VEHICLE
MA002–11
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
These are maintenance and inspection items which are considered to be the owner’s responsibility.
They can be done by the owner or they can have them done at a service shop.
These items include those which should be checked on a daily basis, those which, in most cases, do not
require (special) tools and those which are considered to be reasonable for the owner to do.
Items and procedures for general maintenance are as follows.
1.
GENERAL NOTES
Maintenance items may vary from country to country. Check the owner’s manual supplement in which
the maintenance schedule is shown.
Every service item in the periodic maintenance schedule must be performed.
Periodic maintenance service must be performed according to whichever interval in the periodic maintenance schedule occurs first, the odometer reading (miles) or the time interval (months).
Maintenance service after the last period should be performed at the same interval as before unless
otherwise noted.
Failure to do even one item an cause the engine to run poorly and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
LIGHTS
(a) Check that the headlights, stop lights, taillights, turn signal lights, and other lights are all working.
(b) Check the headlight aim.
3.
WARNING LIGHTS AND BUZZERS
Check that all warning lights and buzzers function properly.
4.
HORN
Check that it is working.
5.
WINDSHIELD GLASS
Check for scratches, pits or abrasions.
6.
WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
(a) Check operation of the wipers and washer.
(b) Check that the wipers do not streak.
7.
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTER
Check that air comes out from the defroster outlet when operating the heater or air conditioner.
8.
REAR VIEW MIRROR
Check that it is mounted securely.
9.
SUN VISORS
Check that they move freely and are mounted securely.
10. STEERING WHEEL
Check that it has the specified freeplay. Be alert for changes in steering condition, such as hard steering,
excessive freeplay or strange noises.
11. SEATS
(a) Check that the seat adjusters operate smoothly.
(b) Check that all latches lock securely in any position.
(c) Check that the head restraints move up and down smoothly and that the locks hold securely in any
latch position.
(d) For fold–down seat backs, check that the latches lock securely.
12. SEAT BELTS
(a) Check that the seat belt system such as the buckles, retractors and anchors operate properly and
smoothly.
(b) Check that the belt webbing is not cut, frayed, worn or damaged.
Author:
Date:
45
MA–3
MAINTENANCE
–
INSIDE VEHICLE
13. ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Check the pedal for smooth operation and uneven pedal effort or catching.
14. CLUTCH PEDAL (See page CL–2)
(a) Check the pedal for smooth operation.
(b) Check that the pedal has the proper freeplay.
15. BRAKE PEDAL (See page BR–5)
(a) Check the pedal for smooth operation.
(b) Check that the pedal has the proper reserve distance and freeplay.
(c) Check the brake booster function.
16. BRAKES
At a safe place, check that the brakes do not pull to one side when applied.
17. PARKING BRAKE (See page BR–8)
(a) Check that the lever has the proper travel.
(b) On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is held securely with only the parking brake applied.
18. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION ”PARK” MECHANISM
(a) Check the lock release button of the selector lever for proper and smooth operation.
(b) On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is held securely with the selector lever in ”P” position and all
brakes released.
Author:
Date:
46
MA–4
MAINTENANCE
–
UNDER HOOD
UNDER HOOD
MA003–09
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
GENERAL NOTES
Maintenance items may vary from country to country. Check the owner’s manual supplement in which
the maintenance schedule is shown.
Every service item in the periodic maintenance schedule must be performed.
Periodic maintenance service must be performed according to whichever interval in the periodic maintenance schedule occurs first, the odometer reading (miles) or the time interval (months).
Maintenance service after the last period should be performed at the same interval as before unless
otherwise noted.
Failure to do even one item an cause the engine to run poorly and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID
Check that there is sufficient fluid in the tank.
3.
ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
Check that the coolant level is between the ”FULL” and ”LOW” lines on the see–through reservoir.
4.
RADIATOR AND HOSES
(a) Check that the front of the radiator is clean and not blocked with leaves, dirt or bugs.
(b) Check the hoses for cracks, kinks, rot or loose connections.
5.
BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check that the electrolyte level of all battery cells is between the upper and lower level lines on the case.
6.
BRAKE AND CLUTCH FLUID LEVELS
(a) Check that the brake and clutch fluid levels are near the upper level line on the see–through reservoirs.
(b) Check that the clutch fluid level is with is ± 5 mm (0.20 in.). of the reservoir hem.
7.
ENGINE DRIVE BELTS
Check drive belt for fraying, cracks, wear or oiliness.
8.
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
Check the level on the dipstick with the engine turned off.
9.
POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL
Check the level.
The level should be in the ”HOT” or ”COLD” range depending on the fluid temperature.
10. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID LEVEL
(a) Park the vehicle on a level surface.
(b) With the engine idling and the parking brake applied, shift the selector into all positions from ”P” to ”L”,
and then shift into ”P” position.
(c) Pull out the dipstick and wipe off the fluid with a clean rag. Re–insert the dipstick and check that the
fluid level is in the HOT range.
(d) Do this check with the fluid at normal driving temperature (70 – 80°C, 158 – 176°F).
HINT:
Wait until the engine cools down (approx. 30 min.) before checking the fluid level after extended driving at
high speeds, in hot weather, in heavy traffic or pulling a trailer.
11. EXHAUST SYSTEM
If any change in the sound of the exhaust or smell of the exhaust fumes is noticed, have the cause located
and corrected.
Author:
Date:
47
MA–5
MAINTENANCE
–
ENGINE
ENGINE
MA00L–01
INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
REPLACE TIMING BELT
5S–FE: (See page EM–17)
1MZ–FE: (See page EM–15)
INSPECT DRIVE BELTS
5S–FE: (See page CH–1)
1MZ–FE: (See page CH–1)
REPLACE SPARK PLUGS
5S–FE: (See page IG–1)
1MZ–FE: (See page IG–1)
4.
(a)
Outside
Inside
P00495
INSPECT AIR FILTER
Visually check that the air filter is not excessively dirty or
oily.
(b) Clean the air filter with compressed air.
First blow from the inside thoroughly, then blow off the outside
of the air filter.
5.
REPLACE AIR FILTER
Replace the air filter with a new one.
6.
REPLACE ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER
5S–FE: (See page LU–2)
1MZ–FE: (See page LU–3)
7.
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
5S–FE: (See page CO–2)
1MZ–FE: (See page CO–2)
8.
1MZ–FE:
INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER
(See page EC–6)
9.
REPLACE GASKET IN FUEL TANK CAP
5S–FE: (See page EC–6)
1MZ–FE: (See page EC–6)
10. INSPECT FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS
5S–FE: (See page EC–6)
1MZ–FE: (See page EC–6)
11. INSPECT EXHAUST PIPES AND MOUNTINGS
5S–FE: (See page EC–15)
1MZ–FE: (See page EC–17)
12. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
5S–FE: (See page EM–4)
1MZ–FE: (See page EM–4)
Author:
Date:
48
MA–6
MAINTENANCE
–
BRAKE
BRAKE
MA00M–01
INSPECTION
MA0055
1.
INSPECT BRAKE LINE PIPES AND HOSES
HINT:
Check in a well lighted area. Check the entire circumference
and length of the brake hoses using a mirror as required. Turn
the front wheels fully right or left before checking the front brake.
(a) Check all brake lines and hoses for:
Damage
Wear
Deformation
Cracks
Corrosion
Leaks
Bends
Twists
(b) Check all clamps for tightness and connections for leakage.
(c) Check that the hoses and lines are clear of sharp edges,
moving parts and the exhaust system.
(d) Check that the lines installed in grommets pass through
the center of the grommets.
2.
INSPECT FRONT BRAKE PADS AND DISCS
(See page BR–22)
3.
INSPECT REAR BRAKE PADS AND DISCS
(See page BR–37)
4.
INSPECT BRAKE LININGS AND DRUMS
(See page BR–34)
Author:
Date:
49
MA–7
MAINTENANCE
–
CHASSIS
CHASSIS
MA00N–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT STEERING LINKAGE
Check the steering wheel freeplay. (See page SR–8)
Check the steering linkage for looseness or damage.
Check that:
Tie rod ends do not have excessive play.
Dust seals and boots are not damaged.
Boot clamps are not loose.
2.
INSPECT SRS AIRBAG (See page RS–2)
3.
INSPECT STEERING GEAR HOUSING OIL
Check the steering gear housing for oil leakage.
4.
INSPECT DRIVE SHAFT BOOTS
Check the drive shaft boots for clamp looseness, leakage or
damage.
5.
(a)
N01022
INSPECT BALL JOINTS AND DUST COVERS
Inspect the ball joints for excessive looseness.
Jack up the front of the vehicle and place wooden
blocks with a height of 180 – 200 mm (7.09 – 7.87
in.) under the front tires.
Lower the jack until there is about half a load on the
front coil spring. Place stands under the vehicle for
safety.
Check that the front wheels are pointing straight
ahead, and block them with chocks.
Using a lever, pry up the end of the lower arm, and
check the amount of play.
Maximum ball joint vertical play: 0 mm (0 in.)
If there is play, replace the ball joint.
(b) Check the dust cover for damage.
6.
CHECK TRANSAXLE OIL (FLUID)
(a) Visually check the transaxle for oil (fluid) leakage.
If leakage is found, check for the cause and repair.
7.
(a)
(b)
REPLACE TRANSAXLE OIL (FLUID)
M/T:
Replace the transaxle oil.
S51: (See page MX–4)
E153: (See page MX–4)
A/T:
Replace the transaxle fluid.
A140E: (See page DI–389)
A541E: (See page DI–438)
Author:
Date:
50
MA–8
MAINTENANCE
–
BODY
BODY
MA00O–01
INSPECTION
1.
TIGHTEN BOLTS AND NUTS ON CHASSIS AND
BODY
Tighten these parts:
Front seat mount bolts
Torque: 37 N·m (375 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
MA0676
B00995
Front suspension member–to–body mounting bolts
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
N21126
Rear suspension member–to–body mounting nuts
Torque: 51 N·m (520 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
Check that the brakes work properly and do not drag.
N21125
2.
(a)
(b)
FINAL INSPECTION
Check the operation of the body parts:
Hood:
Auxiliary catch operates properly
Hood locks securely when closed
Front and rear doors:
Door lock operates properly
Doors close properly
Luggage compartment door and back door:
Door lock operates properly
Seats:
Seat adjusts easily and locks securely in any position
Front seat back locks securely in any position
Folding–down rear seat backs lock securely
Road test:
Check the engine and chassis for abnormal noises.
Check that the vehicle does not wander or pull to
one side.
Author:
Date:
51
MA–9
MAINTENANCE
–
(c)
Be
BODY
Check that the brakes work properly and do not
drag.
Do setting of the parking brake shoes and drum.
sure to deliver a clean car. Especially check:
Steering wheel
Shift lever knob
All switch knobs
Door handles
Seats
Author:
Date:
52
MA–1
MAINTENANCE
–
ENGINE
ENGINE
MA00L–02
INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
REPLACE TIMING BELT (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
EM–17)
INSPECT DRIVE BELTS (See Pub. No. RM654U, page
CH–1)
REPLACE SPARK PLUGS (See page IG–1)
4.
(a)
Outside
Inside
P00495
INSPECT AIR CLEANER FILTER
Visually check that the air filter is not excessively dirty or
oily.
(b) Clean the air cleaner filter with compressed air.
First blow from the inside thoroughly, then blow off the
outside of the air cleaner filter.
5.
REPLACE AIR CLEANER FILTER
Replace the air filter with a new one.
6.
REPLACE ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER (See Pub. No.
RM654U, page LU–2)
7.
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT (See Pub. No. RM654U,
page CO–2)
8.
INSPECT FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR RESERVOIR (See page SF–6)
9.
INSPECT FUEL FILTER (See page SF–3)
10. REPLACE FUEL FILTER (See page SF–5)
11. INSPECT FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS
Visually check for loose connections, sharp bends or damage.
12. INSPECT FUEL TANK BAND (See page SF–18)
13. INSPECT FUEL TANK
(a) Check for fuel leaks (See page SF–1).
(b) Check the fuel tank mounting (See page SF–18).
14. REPLACE FUEL TANK (See page SF–18)
15. INSPECT EXHAUST PIPES AND MOUNTINGS (See
Pub. No. RM654U, page EC–15)
16. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE (See page EM–4)
Author:
Date:
42
CO–1
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
COOLANT
COOLANT
CO066–03
INSPECTION
HINT:
Check the coolant level when the engine is cold.
1.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RADIATOR RESERVOIR
The engine coolant level should be between the ”LOW” and ”FULL” lines.
If low, check for leaks and add ”Toyota Long Life Coolant” or equivalent up to the ”FULL” line.
2.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator
are still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b) There should not be any excessive deposits of rust or scale around the radiator cap or radiator filler
hole, and the coolant should be free from oil.
If excessively dirty, replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
Author:
Date:
1575
CO–2
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
COOLANT
CO067–03
REPLACEMENT
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot, as fluid
and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b)
Radiator Drain Plug
Engine Drain Plug
Z18990
Loosen the radiator drain plug (on the right side of the radiator lower tank) and engine drain plug (on the left rear
of the cylinder block), and drain the coolant.
(c) Close the drain plugs.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf) for engine
2.
FILL ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Slowly fill the system with coolant.
Use of improper coolants may damage engine cooling system.
Use ”Toyota Long Life Coolant” or equivalent and
mix it with plan water according to the manufacturer’s directions.
Using of coolant which includes more than 50 %
(freezing protection down to –35°C (–31°F) or 60 %
(freezing protection down to –50°C (–58°F)) of ethylene–glycol is recommended but not more than 70
%.
NOTICE:
Do not use an alcohol type coolant or plain water
alone.
The coolant should be mixed with plain water (preferably demineralized water or distilled water).
Capacity:
(b)
(c)
(d)
3.
w/ Oil cooler
6.9 litters (7.3 US qts, 6.1 lmp. qts)
w/o Oil cooler
6.2 litters (6.5 US qts, 5.4 lmp. qts)
Install the radiator cap.
Start the engine, and bleed the cooling system.
Refill the radiator reservoir with coolant until it reaches the
”FULL” line.
CHECK FOR COOLANT LEAKS
Author:
Date:
1576
CO–3
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
WATER PUMP
CO068–03
COMPONENTS
64 (650, 47)
64 (650, 47)
Engine Moving Control Rod
52 (530, 38)
Ground Strap Connector
No.2 RH Engine Mounting Bracket
Generator Drive Belt
w/ Oil Cooler
A/C Compressor
Connector
A/C Compressor
Cylinder Block Insulator
PS Pump Drive Belt
RH Front Fender Apron Seal
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
S05543
Author:
Date:
1577
CO–4
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
Generator Wire
Generator Connector
* Gasket
Generator
Wire
Clamp
No.2 Timing Belt
Cover
Wire Clamp
Timing Belt
No.1 Timing Belt
Cover
Timing Belt Guide
High–Tension Cord
Crankshaft
Pulley
Spark Plug
* Gasket
18 (180,13)
Wire Clamp
108 (1,100, 80)
Wire Clamp
O–Ring
Wire Clamp
No.1 Idler Pulley
42 (425,31)
Tension Spring
O–Ring
No.2 Idler Pulley
Gasket
42 (425,31)
Generator Drive Belt
Adjusting Bar
Water Pump and
Water Pump Cover
Assembly
Wire Clamp
Lower
Radiator
Hose
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Connector
Water Pump
Cover
Gasket
Water Pump
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
* Replace only if damaged
Non–reusable part
S05939
Author:
Date:
1578
CO–5
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
CO069–04
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page EM–17)
DISCONNECT LOWER RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER OUTLET
4.
REMOVE TIMING BELT TENSION SPRING
Loosen the No.1 idler pulley bolt, and remove the tension
spring.
5.
REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
Remove the bolt and idler pulley.
6.
w/ Oil Cooler:
REMOVE A/C COMPRESSOR (See page EM–69)
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE GENERATOR DRIVE BELT ADJUSTING
BAR
Disconnect the engine wire clamp from the adjusting bar.
Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector
from the bracket on the adjusting bar.
Remove the bolt and adjusting bar.
S05599
8.
(a)
REMOVE WATER PUMP AND WATER PUMP COVER
ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 nuts holding the water pump to the water
bypass pipe.
S05924
(b)
Remove the 3 bolts in the sequence shown.
1
3
2
S05963
Author:
Date:
1579
CO–6
COOLING (5S–FE)
Disconnect
–
WATER PUMP
(c)
Disconnect the water pump cover from the water bypass
pipe, and remove the water pump and water pump cover
assembly.
(d) Remove the gasket and 2 O–rings from the water pump
and water bypass pipe.
9.
REMOVE WATER PUMP FROM WATER PUMP COVER
Remove the 3 bolts, water pump and gasket.
S05965
Author:
Date:
1580
CO–7
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
CO06A–03
INSPECTION
Turn
Air Hole
S01486
1.
INSPECT WATER PUMP
(a) Visually check the air hole for coolant leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the water pump.
If engine coolant has leaked onto the timing belt, replace the
timing belt.
(b) Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump bearing
moves smoothly and quietly.
If necessary, replace the water pump.
2.
INSPECT TIMING BELT COMPONENTS
(See page EM–22)
Author:
Date:
1581
CO–8
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
CO06B–03
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL WATER PUMP TO WATER PUMP COVER
Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.8 N·m (90 kgf·cm, 78 in.·lbf)
N00918
2.
Connect
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
INSTALL WATER PUMP AND WATER PUMP COVER
ASSEMBLY
Install new O–ring and gasket to water pump cover.
Install a new O–ring to the water bypass pipe.
Apply soapy water to the O–ring on the water bypass
pipe.
Connect the water pump cover to the water bypass pipe.
Do not install the nuts yet.
S06015
(e)
Install the water pump with the 3 bolts. Tighten the bolts
in the sequence shown.
Torque: 8.8 N·m (90 kgf·cm, 78 in.·lbf)
(f)
Install the 2 nuts holding the water pump cover to the water bypass pipe.
Torque: 9.3 N·m (95 kgf·cm, 82 in.·lbf)
3.
(a)
INSTALL GENERATOR DRIVE BELT ADJUSTING BAR
Install the adjusting bar with the bolt.
Torque: 22 N·m (224 kgf·cm, 16 ft·lbf)
Install the engine wire clamp to the adjusting bar.
Install the crankshaft position sensor connector to the
bracket on the adjusting bar.
w/ Oil Cooler:
INSTALL A/C COMPRESSOR (See page EM–75)
INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY (See page EM–23)
3
1
2
Z19283
S05924
(b)
(c)
4.
S05599
5.
Author:
Date:
1582
CO–9
COOLING (5S–FE)
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
–
WATER PUMP
INSTALL TIMING BELT TENSION SPRING
(See page EM–23)
CONNECT LOWER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER INLET
INSTALL TIMING BELT (See page EM–23)
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR COOLANT LEAKS
Author:
Date:
1583
CO–10
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
THERMOSTAT
THERMOSTAT
CO06C–03
COMPONENTS
w/ Oil Cooler
Oil Filter
Thermostat
Gasket
Water Inlet
Non–reusable part
S05299
Author:
Date:
1584
CO–11
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
THERMOSTAT
CO06D–03
REMOVAL
HINT:
Removal of the thermostat would have an adverse effect, causing a lowering of cooling efficiency. Do not remove the thermostat, even if the engine tends to overheat.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2.
w/ Oil Cooler:
REMOVE OIL FILTER (See page LU–2)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE WATER INLET AND THERMOSTAT
Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the water inlet from
the water pump cover.
Remove the thermostat.
Remove the gasket from the thermostat.
S05322
Author:
Date:
1585
CO–12
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
THERMOSTAT
INSPECTION
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
HINT:
The thermostat is numbered with the valve opening temperature.
CO06E–03
P13560
(a)
Immerse the thermostat in water and gradually heat the
water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature.
Valve opening temperature: 80 – 84°C (176 – 183°F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified, replace the
thermostat.
P00436
(c)
Check the valve lift.
Valve lift: 8 mm (0.31 in.) or more at 95°C (203°F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the thermostat.
(d) Check that the valve is fully closed when the thermostat
is at low temperatures (below 40°C (104°F)).
If not closed, replace the thermostat.
Valve Lift
P24125
Author:
Date:
1586
CO–13
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
THERMOSTAT
CO0SN–01
5° 5°
INSTALLATION
Protrusion
1.
(a)
(b)
Jiggle
Valve
P13611
PLACE THERMOSTAT IN WATER INLET
Install a new gasket to the thermostat.
Align the jiggle valve of the thermostat with the protrusion
of the water inlet, and insert the thermostat in the water
inlet.
HINT:
The jiggle valve may be set within 5° of either side of the prescribed position.
2.
INSTALL WATER INLET AND THERMOSTAT
Install the water inlet and thermostat with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.8 N·m (90 kgf·cm, 78 in.·lbf)
3.
w/ Oil Cooler:
INSTALL OIL FILTER (See page LU–2)
4.
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
5.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR COOLANT LEAKS
6.
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
S05322
Author:
Date:
1587
CO–14
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
RADIATOR
CO06G–03
ON–VEHICLE CLEANING
Using water or a steam cleaner, remove any mud or dirt from the radiator core.
NOTICE:
If using a high pressure type cleaner, be careful not to deform the fins of the radiator core. (i.e. Maintain a distance between the cleaner nozzle and radiator core.)
Author:
Date:
1588
CO–15
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO06H–04
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR CAP
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot, as fluid
and steam can be blown out under pressure.
Radiator Cap Tester
30° or More
Radiator Cap
Z00570
Radiator Cap Tester
B06362
2.
INSPECT RADIATOR CAP
NOTICE:
If the radiator cap has contaminations, always rinse
it with water.
Before using a radiator cap tester, wet the relief valve
and pressure valve with engine coolant or water.
When performing steps (a) and (b) below, keep the
tester at an angle of over 30° above the horizontal.
(a) Using a radiator cap tester, slowly pump the tester and
check that air is coming from the vacuum valve.
Pump speed: 1 push/(3 seconds or more)
NOTICE:
Push the pump at a constant speed.
If air is not coming from the vacuum valve, replace the radiator
cap.
(b) Pump the tester, and measure the relief valve opening
pressure.
Pump speed: 1 push within 1 second
NOTICE:
This pump speed is for the first pump only (in order to close
the vacuum valve). After this, the pump speed can be reduced.
Standard opening pressure:
74 – 103 kPa (0.75 – 1.05 kgf/cm2, 10.7 – 14.9 psi)
Minimum opening pressure:
59 kPa (0.6 kgf/cm2, 8.5 psi)
HINT:
Use the tester’s maximum reading as the opening pressure.
If the opening pressure is less than minimum, replace the radiator cap.
3.
INSPECT COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
(a) Fill the radiator with coolant, and attach a radiator cap tester.
(b) Warm up the engine.
(c) Pump it to 118 kPa (1.2 kgf/cm2, 17.1 psi), and check that
the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator or water pump
for leaks. If no external leaks are found, check the heater core,
cylinder block and head.
4.
REINSTALL RADIATOR CAP
Author:
Date:
1589
CO–16
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO06I–03
COMPONENTS
Upper Radiator Support
No.2 Electric
Cooling Fan
Connector
Radiator Reservoir Hose
Upper Radiator Support
Radiator Assembly
Lower Radiator
Support
No.1 Electric Cooling Fan Connector
ECT Switch Connector
for Electric Cooling Fan
Lower Radiator Hose
Upper Radiator Hose
Oil Cooler Hose for A/T
S05951
Author:
Date:
1590
CO–17
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
No.2 Electric Cooling Fan
ECT Switch
Connector for
Electric Cooling
Fan
Lower Radiator Hose
No.1 Electric Cooling
Fan
Wire
Clamp
Radiator
Oil Cooler Hose
for A/T
S05948
Radiator Cap
Upper Tank
O–Ring
A/T
O–Ring
Plate Washer
Nut
Core
Pipe
Oil Cooler
O–Ring
O–Ring
Nut
Plate Washer
O–Ring
ECT Switch for Electric Cooling Fan
Lower Tank
Drain Plug
O–Ring
Non–reusable part
S05240
Author:
Date:
1591
CO–18
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO06J–04
REMOVAL
1.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
REMOVE RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
Disconnect the No.1 electric cooling fan connector.
Disconnect the No.2 electric cooling fan connector.
Disconnect the ECT switch connector for the electric cooling fan.
Disconnect the upper radiator hose from the radiator.
Disconnect the lower radiator hose from the water inlet.
Disconnect the radiator reservoir hose from the radiator.
A/T:
Disconnect the 2 oil cooler hoses from the oil cooler pipes.
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
(l)
S05955
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 upper radiator supports.
Remove the radiator assembly.
Remove the 2 lower radiator supports.
Remove the lower radiator hose from the radiator.
A/T:
Remove the 2 oil cooler hoses from the radiator.
3.
REMOVE NO.1 ELECTRIC COOLING FAN FROM RADIATOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT switch connector for the cooling fan.
(b) Disconnect the ECT switch wire clamp for the cooling fan
from the bracket of the radiator.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and cooling fan.
4.
REMOVE NO.2 ELECTRIC COOLING FAN FROM RADIATOR
Remove the 2 bolts and cooling fan.
Author:
Date:
1592
CO–19
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO06K–03
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
Part ”A”
Dimension ”B” SST
Claw
Stopper Bolt
Overhaul Handle
CO1205
Lock
Plate
Stopper
Bolt
ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230–01010
(a) Install the claw to the overhaul handle, inserting it in the
hole in part ”A” as shown in the diagram.
(b) While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so that
dimension ”B” is as shown in the illustration.
Dimension: 0.2 – 0.3 mm (0.008 – 0.012 in)
NOTICE:
If this adjustment is not done the claw may be damaged.
4.
UNCAULK LOCK PLATES
Using SST to release the caulking, squeeze the handle until
stopped by the stopper bolt.
SST 09230–01010
Tank
SST
REMOVE ECT SWITCH
Remove the ECT switch.
Remove the O–ring.
REMOVE DRAIN PLUG
Remove the drain plug.
Remove the O–ring.
S04699
5.
REMOVE TANKS AND O–RINGS
Lightly tap the bracket of the radiator (or radiator inlet or outlet)
with a soft–faced hammer, and remove the tank and the O–ring.
Tap
S04703
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
A/T:
REMOVE OIL COOLER FROM LOWER TANK
Loosen the nut, and remove the cooler pipe.
Remove the 2 nuts and plate washers.
Remove the oil cooler and 2 O–rings.
S04705
Author:
Date:
1593
CO–20
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO06L–04
REASSEMBLY
Pipe
1.
18°
Downward
(a)
(b)
(c)
S05307
Lock Plate
Lock Plate
Core
CO1267
Normal X Twisted
A/T:
INSTALL OIL COOLER TO LOWER TANK
Install 2 new O–rings to the oil cooler.
Install the oil cooler to the lower tank with the 2 plate
washers and nuts.
Torque: 8.3 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
Install the cooler pipe in the direction indicated in the illustration.
Torque: 14.7 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
2.
INSPECT LOCK PLATE FOR DAMAGE
HINT:
If the sides of the lock plate groove are deformed, reassembly of the tank will be impossible.
Therefore, first correct any deformation with pliers or similar object. Water leakage will result if the bottom of the
lock plate groove is damaged or dented.
NOTICE:
The radiator can only be recaulked 2 times. After the 2nd
time, the radiator core must be replaced.
3.
INSTALL NEW O–RINGS AND TANKS
(a) After checking that there are no foreign objects in the lock
plate groove, install the new O–ring without twisting it.
HINT:
When cleaning the lock plate groove, lightly rub it with sand paper without scratching it.
O–Ring
X Twisted
CO0317
CORRECT
WRONG
Tap
Tank
(b)
(c)
Install the tank without damaging the O–ring.
Tap the lock plate with a soft–faced hammer so that there
is no gap between it and the tank.
Lock
Plate
S04698
Author:
Date:
1594
CO–21
COOLING (5S–FE)
4.
Part ”A”
(a)
(b)
Dimension ”B” SST
Punch Assembly
Stopper Bolt
Overhaul Handle
7
3
1
2
4
6
8
SST
RADIATOR
ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230–01010, 09231–14010
Install the punch assembly to the overhaul handle, inserting it in the hole in part ”A” as shown in the illustration.
While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so that
dimension ”B” is as shown in the illustration.
Dimension: 8.4 mm (0.331 in)
CO1206
5.
(a)
5
–
CAULK LOCK PLATE
Lightly press SST against the lock plate in the order
shown in the illustration. After repeating this a few times,
fully caulk the lock plate by squeezing the handle until
stopped by the stopper plate.
SST 09230–01010
Tank
Lock
Plate
Stopper
Bolt
Z18947
(2)
(3)
HINT:
Do not stake the areas protruding around the pipes,
brackets or tank ribs.
The points shown in the illustration and oil cooler near
here (A/T) cannot be staked with the SST. Use pliers or
similar object and be careful not to damage the core
plates.
(3)
(3)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
S05241
Z18946
Author:
Date:
1595
CO–22
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
(b)
H
S04700
Check the lock plate height (H) after completing the caulking.
Plate height: 7.40 – 7.80 mm (0.2913 – 0.3071 in.)
If not within the specified height, adjust the stopper bolt of the
handle again and caulk again.
6.
INSTALL ECT SWITCH
(a) Install a new O–ring to the ECT switch.
(b) Install the ECT switch.
7.
INSTALL DRAIN PLUG
(a) Install a new O–ring to the drain plug.
(b) Install the drain plug.
8.
(a)
SST
(b)
(c)
INSPECT FOR WATER LEAKS
Plug the inlet and outlet pipes of the radiator with SST.
SST 09230–01010
Using a radiator cap tester, apply pressure to the radiator.
Test pressure: 177 kPa (1.8 kgf/cm2, 26 psi)
Submerge the radiator in water.
S04704
Tank
Lock
Plate
O–Ring
(d) Inspect for leaks.
HINT:
On radiators with resin tanks, there is a clearance between the
tank and lock plate where a minute amount of air will remain,
giving the appearance of an air leak when the radiator is submerged in water. Therefore, before doing the water leak test,
first swish the radiator around in the water until all air bubbles
disappear.
S01713
Author:
Date:
1596
CO–23
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO06M–03
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
2.
(a)
(b)
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
S05955
(j)
(k)
(l)
4.
5.
INSTALL NO.1 ELECTRIC COOLING FAN TO RADIATOR
Attach the lower side of the cooling fan to the bracket of
the radiator.
Install the cooling fan with the 2 bolts.
Connect the ECT switch connector for the cooling fan.
Install the ECT switch wire clamp for the cooling fan to the
bracket of the radiator.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 44 in.·lbf)
INSTALL NO.2 ELECTRIC COOLING FAN TO RADIATOR
Attach the lower side of the cooling fan to the bracket of
the radiator.
Install the cooling fan with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 44 in.·lbf)
INSTALL RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
Install the lower radiator hose to the radiator.
A/T:
Install the 2 oil cooler hoses to the radiator.
Install the 2 lower radiator supports to the radiator.
Attach the 2 lower radiator supports on the radiator to the
body brackets.
Install the 2 upper radiator supports with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 12.8 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Connect the upper radiator hose to the radiator.
Connect the lower radiator hose to the water inlet.
Connect the radiator reservoir hose to the radiator.
A/T:
Connect the 2 oil cooler hoses to the oil cooler pipes.
Connect the No.1 electric cooling fan connector.
Connect the No.2 electric cooling fan connector.
Connect the ECT switch connector for the electric cooling
fan.
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR COOLANT LEAKS
Author:
Date:
1597
CO–24
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO06N–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
S05959
ECT Switch
Connector
S05953
No.1
Ammeter
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION WITH LOW TEMPERATURE (Below 83°C (181°F))
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Check that the cooling fan stops.
If not, check the cooling fan relay and ECT switch, and check
for a separated connector or severed wire between the cooling
fan relay and ECT switch.
(c) Disconnect the ECT switch connector.
(d) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If not, check the fan main relay, cooling fan relay, cooling fan,
fuses, and check for short circuit between the cooling fan relay
and ECT switch.
(e) Reconnect the ECT switch connector.
2.
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION WITH HIGH TEMPERATURE (Above 93°C (199°F))
(a) Start the engine, and raise coolant temperature to above
93°C (199°F).
(b) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If not, replace the ECT switch.
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(+)
(–)
(d)
No.2
INSPECT COOLING FANS
Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
Connect battery and ammeter to the connector.
Check that the cooling fan rotates smoothly, and check
the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 4.9 – 8.5 A
Reconnect the cooling fan connector.
Battery
(–) Ammeter
(+)
Battery
Z19282
Author:
Date:
1598
CO–25
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO06O–03
COMPONENTS
No.1 Cooling Fan
No.1 Electric Cooling Fan Connector
No.1 Electric Cooling Fan
Connector
Holder
ECT Switch
Connector
ECT Switch
Wire
Upper Radiator Hose
S05950
No.1 Cooling Fan
Fan Motor
Connector Holder
Fan
Fan Shroud
S05238
Author:
Date:
1599
CO–26
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
No.2 Cooling Fan
No.2 Electric Cooling Fan
Connector
No.2 Electric Cooling Fan
S05949
No.2 Cooling Fan
Connector Holder
Fan
Fan Motor Cover
Fan Motor
Fan Shroud
S05239
Author:
Date:
1600
CO–27
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO06P–03
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NO.1 COOLING FAN
Drain the engine coolant.
Disconnect the upper radiator hose from the radiator.
(c)
Remove the No.1 cooling fan.
(1) Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
(2) Disconnect the ECT switch connector.
(3) Remove the 2 bolts, and disconnect the cooling fan
from the radiator.
(4) Disconnect the connector holder and wire for the
ECT switch from the fan shroud, and remove the
cooling fan.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE NO.2 COOLING FAN
Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
Remove the 2 bolts and cooling fan.
S05956
S05957
Author:
Date:
1601
CO–28
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO06Q–03
DISASSEMBLY
S05234
1.
REMOVE FAN
Remove the nut and fan.
2.
No.2 Cooling Fan:
REMOVE FAN MOTOR COVER
Remove the 2 screws and motor cover.
3.
REMOVE FAN MOTOR
(a) Disconnect the wire and connector holder from the fan
shroud.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and fan motor.
Author:
Date:
1602
CO–29
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO06R–04
REASSEMBLY
No.1 Cooling Fan
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
INSTALL FAN MOTOR
Install the fan motor with the 3 screws.
Install the wire and connector holder to the fan shroud.
No.2 Cooling Fan:
INSTALL FAN MOTOR COVER
Install the motor cover with the 2 screws.
3.
INSTALL FAN
Install the fan with the nut.
No.2 Cooling Fan
Z19069
Author:
Date:
1603
CO–30
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO06S–03
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
Attach
S06016
(b)
(c)
(d)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
INSTALL NO.1 COOLING FAN
Install the No.1 cooling fan.
(1) Attach the lower side of the cooling fan to the bracket of the radiator.
(2) Install the cooling fan with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 44 in.·lbf)
(3) Install the wire and connector holder for the ECT
switch to the fan shroud.
(4) Connect the cooling fan connector.
(5) Connect the ECT switch connector.
Connect the upper radiator hose to the radiator
Fill with engine coolant
Start the engine and check for coolant leaks
INSTALL NO.2 COOLING FAN
Attach the lower side of the cooling fan to the bracket of
the radiator.
Install the cooling fan with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 44 in.·lbf)
Connect the cooling fan connector.
Attach
S06017
Author:
Date:
1604
CO–31
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SWITCH
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE (ECT) SWITCH
CO06T–03
INSPECTION
ECT Switch Connector
ECT
Switch
O–Ring
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE ECT SWITCH
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the ECT switch.
Remove the O–ring from the ECT switch.
S05245
3.
(a)
Ohmmeter
P05962
INSPECT ECT SWITCH
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminals when the coolant temperature is
above 93°C (199°F).
If there is continuity, replace the switch.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the terminals when the coolant temperature is below 83°C (181°F).
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
4.
REINSTALL ECT SWITCH
(a) Install a new O–ring to the ECT switch.
(b) Install the ECT switch.
(c) Connect the connector.
5.
REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
6.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR COOLANT LEAKS
Author:
Date:
1605
CO–32
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
CO06U–03
INSPECTION
Engine
Main Relay
1.
2.
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
REMOVE ENGINE MAIN RELAY (Marking: ENGINE
MAIN)
S05391
Ohmmeter
3.
(a)
Ohmmeter
Continuity
2
Ohmmeter
1
5
3
4
Continuity
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
B02803
(b)
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
2
1
5 4
3
INSPECT ENGINE MAIN RELAY
Inspect the relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is continuity between terminals 2
and 4.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(3) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
1 and 2.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
Continuity
Battery
B02804
Inspect the relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 3
and 5.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between terminals 2 and 4.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
(3) Check that there is continuity between terminals 1
and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
4.
REINSTALL ENGINE MAIN RELAY
5.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
Author:
Date:
1606
CO–33
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
COOLING FAN RELAY
COOLING FAN RELAY
CO06V–03
INSPECTION
No.1 Cooling
Fan Relay
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT NO.1 COOLING FAN RELAY
Remove the relay box cover.
Remove the No.1 cooling fan relay. (Marking: FAN NO.1)
S05390
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
1
Continuity
4
3
(c)
Inspect the No.1 cooling fan relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is continuity between terminals 3
and 4.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
2
Continuity
B02801
(d)
Ohmmeter
1
No Continuity
Battery
3
4
2
Inspect the No.1 cooling fan relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between terminals 3 and 4.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
(e) Reinstall the No.1 cooling fan relay
(f)
Reinstall the relay box cover.
B02802
No.2 Cooling
Fan Relay
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT NO.2 COOLING FAN RELAY
Remove the relay box cover.
Remove the No.2 cooling fan relay. (Marking: FAN NO.2)
S05387
Ohmmeter
(c)
Continuity
4
2 Ohmmeter
1
5
Ohmmeter
3
Continuity
No Continuity
S04972
Inspect the No.2 cooling fan relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is continuity between terminals 3
and 4.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(3) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
3 and 5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
Author:
Date:
1607
CO–34
COOLING (5S–FE)
–
COOLING FAN RELAY
(d)
4
2 Ohmmeter
5
1
Battery
Ohmmeter
3
No Continuity
Continuity
S04971
No.3 Cooling
Fan Relay
Inspect the No.2 cooling fan relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between terminals 3 and 4
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
(3) Check that there is continuity between terminals 3
and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(e) Reinstall the No.2 cooling fan relay.
(f)
Reinstall the relay box cover.
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT NO.3 COOLING FAN RELAY
Remove the relay box cover.
Remove the No.3 cooling fan relay. (Marking: FAN NO.3)
S05388
(c)
Continuity
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
2
1
5
3
Inspect the No.3 cooling fan relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
3 and 5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
No Continuity
S04970
(d)
2
Ohmmeter
1
5
3
Battery
Continuity
Inspect the No.3 cooling fan relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(e) Reinstall the No.3 cooling fan relay.
(f)
Reinstall the relay box cover.
S04969
Author:
Date:
1608
CO–1
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
COOLANT
COOLANT
CO03B–04
INSPECTION
1.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL AT RADIATOR RESERVOIR
The engine coolant level should be between the ”LOW” and ”FULL” lines, when the engine is cold.
If low, check for leaks and add ’’Toyota Long Life Coolant” or Equivalent up to the ”FULL” line.
2.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap from the water outlet.
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator
are still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b) There should not be any excessive deposits of rust or scale around the radiator cap or water outlet
filler hole, and the coolant should be free from oil.
If excessively dirty, clean the coolant passages and replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
Author:
Date:
1609
CO–2
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
COOLANT
CO03C–04
REPLACEMENT
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Remove the radiator cap from the water outlet.
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot, as fluid
and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b)
Drain Plug
Drain Plug
Z18835
Loosen the radiator drain plug and engine drain plugs,
and drain the coolant.
(c) Close the drain plugs.
Torque:
RH engine drain plug on EGR cooler:
7 N·m (70 kgf·cm, 61 in.·lbf)
LH engine drain plug on union:
13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
2.
FILL ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Slowly fill the system with coolant.
Use of improper coolants may damage engine cooling system.
Use ”Toyota Long life Coolant” or equivalent and
mix it with plan water according to the manufacturer’s directions.
Using of coolant which includes more than 50 %
(freezing protection down to –35°C (–31°F) or 60 %
(freezing protection down to –50°C (–58°F)) of ethylene–glycol is recommended but not more than 70
%.
NOTICE:
Do not use an alcohol type coolant or plain water
alone.
The coolant should be mixed with plain water (preferably demineralized water or distilled water).
Capacity: 9.2 liters (9.7 US qts, 8.1 lmp. qts)
(b) Install the radiator cap.
(c) Start the engine, and bleed the cooling system.
(d) If necessary, refill coolant into the reservoir up to the
”FULL” line.
3.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT FOR LEAKS
4.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT SPECIFIC GRAVITY
CORRECTLY
Author:
Date:
1610
CO–3
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
WATER PUMP
CO03D–04
COMPONENTS
RH Fender Apron Seal
64 (650, 47)
32 (320, 23)
Generator Drive Belt
Engine Moving
Control Rod
64 (650, 47)
RH Engine Mounting Stay
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Bracket
PS Pump Drive Belt
No.2 RH Engine
Mounting Stay (M/T)
Ground Strap
Engine Coolant Reservoir Hose
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
A06654
Author:
Date:
1611
CO–4
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
Timing Belt
Gasket
No.2 Timing Belt Cover
RH Engine Mounting Bracket
28 (290, 21)
Timing Belt Guide
No.2 Generator
Bracket
No.1 Timing Belt Cover
Gasket
Crankshaft
Pulley
215 (2,200, 159)
Engine Wire Protector
No.2 Idler Pulley
RH Camshaft Timing Pulley
125 (1,300, 94)
*88 (900, 65)
43 (440, 32)
LH Camshaft
Timing Pulley
125 (1,300, 94)
Dust Boot
Timing Belt Tensioner
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
*For use with SST
27 (280, 20)
B06388
Author:
Date:
1612
CO–5
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
Gasket
No.3 Timing Belt Cover
Collar
Bushing
x6
8.5 (85, 74 in.·lbf)
Engine Wire
Gasket
Water Pump
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B04403
Author:
Date:
1613
CO–6
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
CO03E–03
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
REMOVE TIMING BELT (See page EM–15)
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(See page EM–15)
REMOVE NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
(See page EM–15)
REMOVE NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
(See page EM–32)
6.
REMOVE WATER PUMP
Remove the 4 bolts, 2 nuts, water pump and gasket.
P12942
Author:
Date:
1614
CO–7
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
CO03F–03
INSPECTION
P12487
1.
INSPECT WATER PUMP
(a) Visually check the drain hole for coolant leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the water pump.
(b) Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump bearing
moves smoothly and quietly.
If necessary, replace the water pump.
2.
INSPECT TIMING BELT COMPONENTS
(See page EM–19)
Author:
Date:
1615
CO–8
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
WATER PUMP
CO0SO–01
INSTALLATION
P12942
1.
INSTALL WATER PUMP
Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 4 bolts and 2
nuts.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not get oil on the gasket.
2.
INSTALL NO.3 TIMING BELT COVER
(See page EM–57)
3.
INSTALL NO.2 IDLER PULLEY
(See page EM–21)
4.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING PULLEYS
(See page EM–21)
5.
INSTALL TIMING BELT
(See page EM–21)
6.
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
7.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
8.
RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1616
CO–9
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
THERMOSTAT
THERMOSTAT
CO03H–03
COMPONENTS
MAF Meter Connector
EGR Vacuum Hose
EVAP Hose
Air Cleaner Cap
Assembly
No.2 ECT
Switch
Connector
Air Filter
Engine Wire Protector
Thermostat
Gasket
Water Inlet
O–Ring
Water Inlet Pipe
8 (80, 69 in.·lbf)
19.5 (200, 14)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
B06397
Author:
Date:
1617
CO–10
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
THERMOSTAT
CO03I–03
REMOVAL
HINT:
Removal of the thermostat would have an adverse effect, causing a lowering of cooling efficiency. Do not remove the thermostat, even if the engine tends to overheat.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER CAP ASSEMBLY AND AIR
FILTER
3.
DISCONNECT NO.2 ECT SWITCH CONNECTOR
4.
DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE PROTECTOR FROM
WATER INLET AND RH CYLINDER HEAD
Remove the 2 nuts, and disconnect the engine wire protector
from the water inlet and cylinder head.
S04581
5.
(b)
DISCONNECT WATER INLET PIPE FROM WATER
INLET AND LH CYLINDER HEAD
Remove the bolt, and disconnect the inlet pipe from the
water inlet.
Remove the O–ring from the inlet pipe.
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE WATER INLET AND THERMOSTAT
Remove the 3 nuts, water inlet and thermostat.
Remove the gasket from the thermostat.
(a)
S04502
S04503
Author:
Date:
1618
CO–11
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
THERMOSTAT
CO03J–03
INSPECTION
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
HINT:
The thermostat is numbered with the valve opening temperature.
P13255
(a)
Immerse the thermostat in water and gradually heat the
water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature.
Valve opening temperature: 80 – 84°C (176 – 183°F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified, replace the
thermostat.
CO0601
(c)
Check the valve lift.
Valve lift: 10.0 mm (0.394 in.) or more at 95°C (203°F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the thermostat.
(d) Check that the valve is fully closed when the thermostat
is at low temperatures (below 40°C (104°F)).
If not closed, replace the thermostat.
10 mm
Z10579
Author:
Date:
1619
CO–12
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
THERMOSTAT
CO03K–03
INSTALLATION
15°
15°
Jiggle Valve
Stud Bolt
S04532
1.
(a)
PLACE THERMOSTAT IN WATER PUMP
Install a new gasket on to the thermostat.
(b)
Align the thermostat jiggle valve with the upper stud bolt,
and insert the thermostat in the water inlet housing.
HINT:
The jiggle valve may be set within 15° of either side of the prescribed position.
2.
INSTALL WATER INLET
Install the water inlet with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
3.
INSTALL WATER INLET PIPE
(a) Install a new O–ring to the water inlet pipe.
(b) Apply soapy water to the O–ring.
(c) Connect the water inlet pipe to the water inlet.
(d) Install the bolt holding the water inlet pipe to the cylinder
head.
Torque: 19.5 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
4.
INSTALL ENGINE WIRE PROTECTOR
5.
CONNECT NO.2 ECT SWITCH CONNECTOR
6.
REINSTALL AIR FILTER AND AIR CLEANER CAP
ASSEMBLY
7.
FILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT
8.
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR LEAKS
9.
RECHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
Author:
Date:
1620
CO–13
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
RADIATOR
CO03L–03
ON–VEHICLE CLEANING
Using water or a steam cleaner, remove any mud or dirt from the radiator core.
NOTICE:
If using a high pressure type cleaner, be careful not to deform the fins of the radiator core. (i.e. Maintain a distance between the cleaner nozzle and radiator core)
Author:
Date:
1621
CO–14
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO03M–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR CAP
CAUTION:
To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and radiator are still hot, as fluid
and steam can be blow out under pressure.
2.
INSPECT RADIATOR CAP
NOTICE:
If the radiator cap has contaminations, always rinse
it with water.
When performing steps (a) and (b) below, keep the radiator cap tester at an angle of over 30° above the horizontal.
Before using a radiator cap tester, wet the relief valve
and pressure valve with engine coolant or water.
(a)
Radiator Cap Tester
30° or More
Radiator Cap
Z00570
Using a radiator cap tester, slowly pump the tester and
check that air is coming from the vacuum valve.
Pump speed: 1 push/(3 seconds or more)
NOTICE:
Push the pump at a constant speed.
If air is not coming from the vacuum valve, replace the radiator
cap.
(b) Pump the tester and measure the relief valve opening
pressure.
Pump speed: 1 push within 1 second
NOTICE:
This pump speed is for the first pump only (in order to close
the vacuum valve). After this, the pump speed can be reduced.
Standard opening pressure:
83 – 113 kPa (0.85 – 1.15 kgf/cm2, 12.1 – 16.4 psi)
Minimum opening pressure:
69 kPa (0.7 kgf/cm2, 10.0 psi)
HINT:
Use the tester’s maximum reading as the opening pressure.
If the opening pressure is less than minimum, replace the radiator cap.
Author:
Date:
1622
CO–15
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
3.
(a)
Radiator Cap
Tester
P13014
INSPECT COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap tester.
(b) Warm up the engine.
(c) Pump it to 127 kPa (1.3 kgf/cm2, 18.5 psi), and check that
the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator or water pump
for leaks. If no external leaks are found, check the heater core,
cylinder block and cylinder head.
4.
REINSTALL RADIATOR CAP
Author:
Date:
1623
CO–16
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO03N–03
COMPONENTS
A/T Oil Cooler Hose
No.2 Cooling Fan
Radiator
No.1 Cooling Fan
O–Ring
No.1 ECT Switch
No.2 Cooling Fan Connector
Upper Radiator Support
No.1 ECT Switch Wire
Lower
Radiator
Hose
Upper Radiator Hose
Upper Radiator Support
No.1 Cooling Fan Connector
Radiator Assembly
Lower Radiator
Support
No.1 ECT Switch Wire Connector
Drain Plug
O–Ring
Lower Radiator
Support
Relay Block
(for Daytime Running Light System)
Lower Radiator Hose
A/T Oil Cooler Hose
Non–reusable part
B06399
Author:
Date:
1624
CO–17
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
Upper Tank
O–Ring
A/T
Oil Cooler
Inlet Pipe
Cushion
Core
Plate Washer
O–Ring
Nut
O–Ring
Lower Tank
Non–reusable part
S04606
Author:
Date:
1625
CO–18
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO03O–03
REMOVAL
HINT:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
(a)
(b)
(c)
At the time of installation, please refer to the following
items.
Start the engine, and check for coolant and A/T fluid
leaks.
Check the A/T fluid level. (See page DI–438)
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
CANADA:
DISCONNECT RELAY BLOCK (FOR DAYTIME
RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM) FROM BATTERY
HOLD–DOWN CLAMP
DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM
RADIATOR
DISCONNECT LOWER RADIATOR HOSE FROM
WATER INLET PIPE
DISCONNECT A/T OIL COOLER HOSES FROM OIL
COOLER PIPES
DISCONNECT NO.1 AND NO.2 COOLING FAN
CONNECTORS
DISCONNECT NO.1 ECT SWITCH WIRE CONNECTOR
REMOVE RADIATOR AND COOLING FANS
ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 bolts and 2 upper supports.
Torque: 12.8 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Lift out the radiator, and remove the radiator and cooling
fans assembly.
Remove the 2 lower supports.
S04725
9.
Lower
Hose
10.
REMOVE A/T OIL COOLER HOSES FROM
RADIATOR
REMOVE LOWER RADIATOR HOSE FROM
RADIATOR
Oil
Cooler
Hose
B05937
Author:
Date:
1626
CO–19
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
11.
–
RADIATOR
REMOVE NO.1 ECT SWITCH
S04588
No.1
12. REMOVE NO.1 COOLING FAN FROM RADIATOR
Remove the 2 bolts and cooling fan.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 44 in.·lbf)
13. REMOVE NO.2 COOLING FAN FROM RADIATOR
Remove the 3 bolts and cooling fan.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 44 in.·lbf)
No.2
B05938
Author:
Date:
1627
CO–20
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO03P–03
Part ”A”
Dimension ”B”
Claw
SST
Stopper Bolt
Overhaul Handle
CO1205
1.
2.
REMOVE CUSHION FROM RADIATOR
ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230–01010
(a) Install the claw to the overhaul handle, inserting it in the
hole in part ”A” as shown in the diagram.
(b) While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so that
dimension ”B” shown in the diagram is 0.2 – 0.5 mm
(0.008 – 0.020 in.).
NOTICE:
If this adjustment is not done, the claw may be damaged.
3.
UNCAULK LOCK PLATES
Using SST to release the caulking, squeeze the handle until
stopped by the stopper bolt.
SST 09230–01010
Tank
Lock Plate
SST
Stopper Bolt
DISASSEMBLY
S04737
4.
(a)
(b)
Tap
REMOVE TANKS AND O–RINGS
Lightly tap the bracket of the radiator (or radiator hose inlet or outlet) with a soft–faced hammer and remove the
tank.
Remove the O–ring.
S04738
5.
A/T
(a)
(b)
(c)
A/T:
REMOVE OIL COOLER FROM LOWER TANK
Remove the pipe.
Remove the nuts and plate washers.
Remove the oil cooler and O–rings.
Z18546
Author:
Date:
1628
CO–21
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO03Q–03
A/T
(2)
REASSEMBLY
(1)
1.
(6)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(5)
(4)
(3)
Z18506
(e)
Lock Plate
Lock Plate
Core
CO1267
2.
INSPECT LOCK PLATE
Inspect the lock plate for damage.
HINT:
If the sides of the lock plate groove are deformed, reassembly of the tank will be impossible.
Therefore, first correct any deformation with pliers or similar object. Water leakage will result if the bottom of the
lock plate groove is damaged or dented, Therefore, repair
or replace if necessary.
NOTICE:
The radiator can only be recaulked 2 times. After the 2nd
time, the radiator core must be replaced.
3.
(a)
Normal X Twisted
O–Ring
A/T:
INSTALL OIL COOLER TO LOWER TANK
Clean the O–ring contact surface of the lower tank and oil
cooler.
Install a new O–rings (1) to the oil cooler (2).
Install the oil cooler with the O–rings to the lower tank (3).
Install the plate washers (4), and nuts (5). Torque the
nuts.
Torque: 8.3 N·m (85 kgf·cm, 74 in.·lbf)
Install the pipe (6).
Torque: 14.7 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
INSTALL NEW O–RINGS AND TANKS
After checking that there are no foreign objects in the lock
plate groove, install the new O–ring without twisting it.
HINT:
When cleaning the lock plate groove, lightly rub it with sand paper without scratching it.
X Twisted
CO0317
Author:
Date:
1629
CO–22
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
CORRECT
–
RADIATOR
(b)
(c)
Install the tank without damaging the O–ring.
Tap the lock plate with a soft–faced hammer so that there
is no gap between it and the tank.
4.
ASSEMBLE SST
SST 09230–01010, 09231–14010
Install the punch assembly to the overhaul handle, inserting it in the hole in part ”A” as shown in the illustration.
While gripping the handle, adjust the stopper bolt so that
dimension ”B” shown in the diagram.
Dimension ”B”: 8.4 mm (0.34 in.)
Tank
WRONG
Lock
Plate
Tap
S04736
Part ”A”
(a)
Dimension ”B”
Punch Assembly
SST
(b)
Stopper Bolt
Overhaul Handle CO1206
5.
(a)
3
5
7
2
1
8
4
6
CAULK LOCK PLATE
Lightly press SST against the lock plate in the order
shown in the illustration. After repeating this a few times,
fully caulk the lock plate by squeezing the handle until
stopped by the stopper plate.
SST 09230–01010
SST
St opper
Bolt
Tank
Lock
Plate
S04739
HINT:
Rib
Do not stake the areas protruding around the pipes,
brackets or tank ribs.
Bracket
S04734
Author:
Date:
1630
CO–23
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
The points shown in the rib sides and oil cooler near here
cannot be staked with SST. Use pliers or similar object
and be careful not to damage the core plates.
S04726
(b)
Check the lock plate height (H) after completing the caulking.
Plate height (H): 7.4 – 7.8 mm (0.2959 – 0.3119 in.)
If not within the specified height, adjust the stopper bolt of the
handle again and caulk again.
6.
INSTALL CUSHION
H
S04735
Author:
Date:
1631
CO–24
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
RADIATOR
CO03R–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page CO–18)
Author:
Date:
1632
CO–25
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO03S–03
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
B05939
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION WITH LOW
TEMPERATURE (Below 88°C (190°F))
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(b) Check that the cooling fan stops.
If not, check the cooling fan relay and ECT switch, and check
for a separated connector or severed wire between the cooling
fan relay and ECT switch.
(c) Disconnect the No.1 ECT switch connector.
Disconnect
S04727
(d) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If not, check the fuses, engine main relay, cooling fan relay,
cooling fan, and check for a short circuit between the cooling
fan relay and ECT switch.
(e) Reconnect the No.1 ECT switch connector.
B05940
2.
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION WITH HIGH
TEMPERATURE (Above 98°C (208°F))
(a) Start the engine, and raise coolant temperature to above
98°C (208°F).
(b) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If not, replace the No.1 ECT switch.
3.
(a)
(b)
Ammeter
(c)
(d)
Battery
INSPECT NO.1 COOLING FAN
Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
Connect battery and ammeter to the cooling fan connector.
Check that the cooling fan rotates smoothly, and check
the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 8.3 – 11.3 A at 20°C (68°F)
Reconnect the cooling fan connector.
B05941
Author:
Date:
1633
CO–26
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
Ammeter
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
INSPECT NO.2 COOLING FAN
Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
Connect battery and ammeter to the cooling fan connector.
Check that the cooling fan rotates smoothly, and check
the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 8.3 – 11.3 A at 20°C (68°F)
Reconnect the cooling fan connector.
Battery B05942
Author:
Date:
1634
CO–27
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO03T–03
COMPONENTS
No.1
Fan
Fan Motor
Clip
Fan Shroud
No.1 Cooling Fan Connector
No.1 Cooling Fan
No.1 ECT Switch Connector
No.1 ECT Switch Wire
Relay Block
(for Daytime Running Light System)
Non–reusable part
B06400
Author:
Date:
1635
CO–28
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
No.2
Fan
Fan Motor
Clip
Fan Shroud
No.2 Cooling Fan Connector
No.2 Cooling Fan
Upper Radiator Hose
Non–reusable part
B06402
Author:
Date:
1636
CO–29
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO03U–03
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE NO.1 COOLING FAN
Canada:
Disconnect the relay block (for daytime running light system) from the battery hold–down clamp.
Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
Disconnect the No.1 ECT switch wire connector.
Disconnect the No.1 ECT switch wire clamps.
(e)
Remove the 2 bolts and cooling fan.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 44 in.·lbf)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE NO.2 COOLING FAN
Drain the engine coolant.
Disconnect the upper radiator hose from the radiator.
Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
(d)
Remove the 3 bolts and cooling fan.
Torque: 5.0 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 44 in.·lbf)
B05943
B05944
Author:
Date:
1637
CO–30
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO03V–03
DISASSEMBLY
Protrusion
B05945
1.
REMOVE NO.1 COOLING FAN
(a) Remove the clip and fan.
NOTICE:
When removing the clip and fan, do not apply too much
force to the motor shaft. And do not scratch the motor
shaft.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install a new clip from the side opposite the protrusion on the
fan.
(b)
Disconnect the lead wire from the fan shroud.
(c)
Remove the 3 screws and fan motor.
S04584
S04587
Protrusion
B05946
2.
REMOVE NO.2 COOLING FAN
(a) Remove the clip and fan.
NOTICE:
When removing the clip and fan, do not apply too much
force to the motor shaft. And do not scratch the motor
shaft.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Install a new clip from the side opposite the protrusion on the
fan.
Author:
Date:
1638
CO–31
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
(b)
Disconnect the lead wire from the fan shroud.
(c)
Remove the 3 screws and fan motor.
S04585
S04586
Author:
Date:
1639
CO–32
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO03W–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly. (See page CO–30)
Author:
Date:
1640
CO–33
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ELECTRIC COOLING FAN
CO03X–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page CO–29)
Author:
Date:
1641
CO–34
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SWITCH
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE (ECT) SWITCH
CO03Y–04
INSPECTION
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
2.
(a)
INSPECT NO.1 ECT SWITCH
Remove the No.1 ECT switch.
No.1 ECT Switch
S04602
(b)
Ohmmeter
P01924
Inspect the No.1 ECT switch.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminals when the coolant temperature is above 98°C (208°F).
If there is continuity, replace the switch.
(2) Check that there is continuity, between the terminals when the coolant temperature is below 88°C
(190°F).
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
(c) Reinstall the No.1 ECT switch.
3.
INSPECT NO.2 ECT SWITCH
(a) Remove the No.2 ECT switch.
No.2 ECT
Switch
S04601
(b)
Ohmmeter
P06722
Inspect the No.2 ECT switch.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals when the coolant temperature is
above 94°C (201°F).
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
(2) Check that there is no continuity between the terminals when the coolant temperature is below 83°C
(181°F).
If there is continuity, replace the switch.
(c) Reinstall the No.2 ECT switch.
Author:
Date:
1642
CO–35
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
4.
5.
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SWITCH
REFILL ENGINE COOLANT
START ENGINE AND CHECK FOR COOLANT LEAKS
Author:
Date:
1643
CO–36
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
ENGINE MAIN RELAY
CO03Z–03
INSPECTION
Engine
Main Relay
1.
2.
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
REMOVE ENGINE MAIN RELAY
(Marking: ENGINE MAIN)
S05391
3.
(a)
Ohmmeter
Continuity
2
1
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
5
4
3
No
Continuity
Continuity
S04974
Ohmmeter No
Continuity
2
1
Ohmmeter
5
4
3
Continuity
Battery
S04973
INSPECT RELAY CONTINUITY
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals 2 and 4.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals 1 and
2.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
4.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT RELAY OPERATION
Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 3 and 5.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between terminals 2 and 4.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
(c) Check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
5.
REINSTALL ENGINE MAIN RELAY
6.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
Author:
Date:
1644
CO–37
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
COOLING FAN RELAY
COOLING FAN RELAY
CO040–03
INSPECTION
No.1 Cooling
Fan Relay
1.
2.
(a)
REMOVE RELAY BOX COVER
INSPECT NO.1 COOLING FAN RELAY
Remove the No.1 cooling fan relay. (Marking: FAN NO.1)
S05390
Ohmmeter
Continuity
Continuity
1
4
Ohmmeter
3
2
(b)
Inspect the No.1 cooling fan relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is continuity between terminals 3
and 4.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
S04975
(c)
Inspect the No.1 cooling fan relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between terminals 3 and 4.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
(d) Reinstall the No.1 cooling fan relay.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
1
4
3
2
Battery
S04976
No.2 Cooling
Fan Relay
3.
(a)
INSPECT NO.2 COOLING FAN RELAY
Remove the No.2 cooling fan relay. (Marking: FAN NO.2)
S05387
(b)
Ohmmeter
4
Ohmmeter
2
1
5
Ohmmeter
3
Continuity
No Continuity
S04972
Inspect the No.2 cooling fan relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is continuity between terminals 3
and 4.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(3) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
3 and 5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
Author:
Date:
1645
CO–38
COOLING (1MZ–FE)
–
COOLING FAN RELAY
(c)
4
2 Ohmmeter
5
1
Battery
Ohmmeter
3
No Continuity
Inspect the No.2 cooling fan relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between terminals 3 and 4.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
(d) Reinstall the No.2 cooling fan relay.
Continuity
S04971
No.3 Cooling
Fan Relay
4.
(a)
INSPECT NO.3 COOLING FAN RELAY
Remove the No.3 cooling fan relay. (Marking: FAN NO.3)
S05388
(b)
Continuity
Ohmmeter
Ohmmeter
2
1
5
3
Inspect the No.3 cooling fan relay continuity.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is mo continuity, replace the relay.
(2) Check that there is no continuity between terminals
3 and 5.
If there is continuity, replace the relay.
No Continuity
S04970
(c)
2
Ohmmeter
1
5
3
Battery
Continuity
Inspect the No.3 cooling fan relay operation.
(1) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1
and 2.
(2) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity
between terminals 3 and 5.
If there is no continuity, replace the relay.
(d) Reinstall the No.3 cooling fan relay.
5.
REINSTALL RELAY BOX COVER
S04969
Author:
Date:
1646
AX–1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
AX034–01
PRECAUTION
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precautions in the IN section.
Author:
Date:
1894
AX–2
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
AX035–01
OPERATION
2nd Brake (B2)
Planetary Gear Unit
1st & Reverse Brake (B3)
2nd Coast brake (B1)
O/D Direct
Forward
One – Way clutch
O/D Brake (B0)
Clutch (C1)
Clutch (C0)
Direct Clutch (C2)
No.2 (F )
2
One Way Clutch
Counter
O/D One – Way
Rear
No.1 (F1)
Drive Gear
Clutch (F0)
Front Planetary
Intermediate Planetary Gear
O/D Planetary Gear
Gear
Shaft
Shift lever
position
P
Gear position
C0
C1
C2
Parking
R
Reverse
N
Neutral
1st
2nd
3rd
D
O/D
2
L
B0
B1
B2
1st
2nd
*3rd
1st
*2nd
B3
Input Shaft
F0
F1
F2
: Operating
*: Down–shift only in the 3rd gear for the 2 position and 2nd gear for the L position no up–shift.
D00989
Author:
Date:
1895
AX–3
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
AX036–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
2.
3.
(a)
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
REMOVE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Remove the bolt and vehicle speed sensor assembly.
Q00207
(b)
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(c)
4.
(a)
Drive Gear
O–Ring
Clip
Q04678
(b)
(c)
5.
6.
Remove the clip and speedometer driven gear from vehicle speed sensor.
Remove the O–ring from vehicle speed sensor.
INSTALL VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Coat a new O–ring with ATF and install it to the vehicle
speed sensor.
Install the speedometer driven gear to the vehicle speed
sensor and clip.
Install the vehicle speed sensor assembly and torque the
bolts.
Torque: 16 N·m (160 kgf·cm, 12 ft·lbf)
CONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
Author:
Date:
1896
AX–4
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP)
SWITCH
AX037–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
(a)
(b)
Q10050
(c)
(d)
5.
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE CONTROL SHAFT LEVER
Remove the nut and control cable.
Remove the nut, washer and control shaft lever.
DISCONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
Pry off the lock washer and remove the nut.
Remove the 2 bolts and park/neutral position switch.
INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
Install the park/neutral position switch with 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
Install a new lock plate and the nut.
Torque: 6.9 N·m (70 kgf·cm, 61 in.·lbf)
Bend claws on the lock plate to fix the nut.
Adjust the park/neutral position switch.
(See page DI–389)
CONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH CONNECTOR
INSTALL CONTROL SHAFT LEVER
Install the control shaft lever, washer and nut.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Install the control cable and nut.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1897
AX–5
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
AX038–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
DRAIN TRANSAXLE FLUID
2.
REMOVE OIL PAN AND GASKET
NOTICE:
Some fluid will remain in the oil pan.
Remove the oil pan bolts, and carefully remove the oil pan assembly. Discard the gasket.
Q00073
3.
EXAMINE PARTICLES IN PAN
Remove the magnets and use them to collect any steel chips.
Look carefully at the chips and particles in the pan and on the
magnet to anticipate what type of wear you will find in the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non–magnetic): bushing wear
AT0103
36 (1.417)
mm (in.)
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE MANUAL VALVE BODY DETENT SPRING
AND MANUAL VALVE BODY
Remove the detent spring on the manual valve body.
Remove the manual valve body.
14 (0.551)
AT2711
Z10944
mm (in.)
20
(0.787)
45
(1.772)
AT3336
50
(1.969)
5.
REMOVE OIL STRAINER AND OIL PIPE BRACKET
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and the oil strainer.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and oil pipe bracket.
NOTICE:
Be careful as oil will come out of the strainer when it is removed.
Z10940
Author:
Date:
1898
AX–6
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
6.
AT0493
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
Z10941
7.
REMOVE OIL PIPES
Pry up the both pipe ends with a large screwdriver and remove
the 4 pipes.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend or damage the pipe.
AT7868
8.
REMOVE VALVE BODY
Remove the 12 bolts.
AT0399
9.
(a)
(b)
10.
REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE
Disconnect the throttle cable.
Remove the valve body.
REMOVE 2ND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
11.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE NO.1 AND NO.2
Remove the 2 bolts and shift solenoid valve No.1.
Remove the bolt and shift solenoid valve No.2.
Remove the 2 O–rings from the shift solenoid valve No.1
and No.2.
OR0038
mm (in.)
16 (0.63)
Shift Solenoid
Valve No.1
16 (0.63)
AT3008
Shift Solenoid
Valve No.2
Z19291
Author:
Date:
1899
AX–7
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
12.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
13.
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
INSTALL SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE NO.1 AND NO.2
Coat 2 new O–rings with ATF.
Install the 2 O–rings to the shift solenoid valve No.1 and
No.2.
Install the shift valve No.1 with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
Install the shift valve No.2 with the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
INSTALL NEW 2ND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
14.
(a)
INSTALL VALVE BODY
While holding the cam down by your hand, slip the cable
end into the slot.
NOTICE:
Do not entangle the solenoid wire.
OR0038
C
B
A
B
A
B
D
C
AT0492
Z10942
(b) Install the valve body with the 12 bolts.
HINT:
Temporarily install the 12 bolts first, then tighten the 12 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 20 mm (0.79 in.)
Bolt B: 25 mm (0.98 in.)
Bolt C: 36 mm (1.42 in.)
Bolt D: 50 mm (1.97 in.)
15. INSTALL OIL PIPES
Using a plastic hammer, install the 4 pipes into the positions indicated in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend or damage the pipes.
AT7870
Shift Solenoid Valve No.1
Shift Solenoid Valve No.2
16. CONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
Connect the black wire harness to shift solenoid valve No.2 and
white wire harness to shift solenoid valve No.1.
White
AT0493
Black
Z10941
Author:
Date:
1900
AX–8
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
mm (in.)
20
(0.78)
45
(1.772)
AT3336
36 (1.417)
17.
(a)
(b)
50
(1.969)
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
INSTALL OIL STRAINER AND OIL PIPE BRACKET
Install the 2 bolts and oil pipe bracket.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Install the 3 bolts and oil strainer.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Z10940
mm (in.)
18.
(a)
(b)
(c)
14 (0.551)
AT2711
–
Z10944
(d)
(e)
INSTALL MANUAL VALVE BODY DETENT SPRING
AND MANUAL VALVE BODY
Align the manual valve with the pin on the manual shaft
lever.
Lower the manual valve body into place.
Temporarily install the 4 bolts first. Then, tighten them with
a torque wrench.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Place the detent spring on the manual valve body and
temporarily install the 2 bolts first.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Check that the manual valve lever is touching the center
of the detent spring tip roller.
19. INSTALL MAGNETS IN OIL PAN
NOTICE:
Make sure that the magnets do not interfere with the oil
pipes.
Magnets
AT2368
Z10945
20. INSTALL OIL PAN AND GASKET
Install a new gasket and oil pan with the 15 bolts.
Torque: 4.9 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 43 in.·lbf)
21. FILL FLUID AND CHECK FLUID LEVEL
(See page DI–389)
Q00073
Author:
Date:
1901
AX–9
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
THROTTLE CABLE
THROTTLE CABLE
AX039–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
(a)
(b)
3.
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
Disconnect the cable from the throttle linkage.
Disconnect the cable from the cable clamps in the engine
compartment.
REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX–4)
REMOVE VALVE BODY (See page AX–5)
4.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE
Remove the retaining bolt and plate.
Pull out the cable from the transaxle case.
5.
IF THROTTLE CABLE IS NEW, STAKE STOPPER OR
PAINT MARK ON INNER CABLE
2.
Q10052
0.8 – 1.5 mm(0.031 – 0.059 in.)
200 mm
(7.87 in.)
Q10339
HINT:
New cable does not have a staked cable stopper.
(a) Bend the cable to ensure a radius of about 200 mm (7.87
in.).
(b) Pull the inner cable lightly until a slight resistance is felt,
and hold it there.
(c) Stake the stopper, 0.8 – 1.5 mm (0.031 – 0.059 in.) from
the end of the outer cable.
(d) Install a new O–ring to the throttle cable.
(e) Push in the throttle cable and install the retaining bolt.
6.
INSTALL VALVE BODY (See page AX–5)
7.
INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX–4)
8.
CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
9.
FILL FLUID AND CHECK FLUID LEVEL
(See page DI–389)
10. ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE (See page DI–389)
Author:
Date:
1902
AX–10
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SL
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SL
AX03A–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
2.
Q10051
3.
(a)
(b)
4.
(a)
(b)
5.
6.
REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX–4)
DISCONNECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SL CONNECTOR
REMOVE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SL
Remove the 2 bolts and shift solenoid valve SL.
Remove the 2 O–rings from the shift solenoid valve SL.
INSTALL SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SL
Coat 2 new O–rings with ATF and install them to the shift
solenoid valve SL.
Install the shift solenoid valve SL and 2 bolts.
CONNECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SL CONNECTOR
INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX–4)
Author:
Date:
1903
AX–11
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL
DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL
AX03B–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
SST
1.
REMOVE LH AND RH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–17)
2.
REMOVE SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
Using SST, drive out the oil seals on both sides.
SST 09308–00010
Q00394
3.
(a)
SST
(b)
4.
Q00247
5.
INSTALL SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32130, 09351–32150)
Oil seal depth:
LH: 2.7 ± 0.5 mm (0.106 ± 0.020 in.)
RH: 0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.020 in.)
Coat the lip of oil seal with MP grease.
INSTALL LH AND RH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–24)
CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL
(See page DI–389)
Author:
Date:
1904
AX–12
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMC Made)
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMC Made)
AX03C–01
LOCATION
Shift Lock Override Cover
Shift Lock Override Button
Stop Light Switch
Key Interlock Solenoid
Shift Lock
Control Unit Assembly
D00760
Author:
Date:
1905
AX–13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMC Made)
AX03D–01
INSPECTION
5 (IG)
1 (ACC)
4
(KLS+)
3 (E)
2 (STP)
Wire Harness Side
D00758
Terminal
1 – 3 (ACC – E)
1.
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL UNIT ASSEMBLY
Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at each terminal.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the shift lock control unit assembly connector.
Measuring Condition
Voltage (V)
Ignition switch ACC
10 – 14
Ignition switch ON
10 – 14
2 – 3 (STP – E)
Depressing brake pedal
10 – 14
4 – 3 (KLS+ – E)
(1) Ignition switch ACC and P position
(2) Ignition switch ACC and except P position
(3) Ignition switch ACC and except P position (After approx. 1 second)
0
7.5 – 11
6 – 9.5
5 – 3 (IG – E)
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
Disconnect the solenoid connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals.
Standard resistance: 12.5 – 16.5 Ω
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the solenoid.
1 (KLS+)
2 (E)
Q09456
(c)
Apply battery positive voltage between terminals. Check
that an operation noise can be heard from the solenoid.
If the solenoid does not operate, replace the solenoid.
1 (KLS+)
2 (E)
Q09457
Author:
Date:
1906
AX–14
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMMK Made)
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMMK Made)
AX03E–01
LOCATION
Shift Lock Override Cover
Shift Lock Override Button
Stop Light Switch
Key Interlock Solenoid
Shift Lock Control ECU
Shift Lock Solenoid
Shift Lock Control Switch
D00759
Author:
Date:
1907
AX–15
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMMK Made)
AX03F–01
3 (IG)
6 (STP)
INSPECTION
1 (ACC)
Back Side
A
4 (KLS+)
–)
5
(SLS
4 (P2)
1.
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL ECU
Using a voltmeter, measure voltage at each terminal.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
1 (P)
B
3 (P1)
2 (SLS+)
Front Side
Q09459
Terminal
A, 1 – A, 5 (ACC – E)
Measuring Condition
Voltage (V)
Ignition switch ACC
10 – 14
Ignition switch ON
10 – 14
A, 6 – A, 5 (STP – E)
Depressing brake pedal
10 – 14
A, 4 – A, 5 (KLS+ – E)
(1) Ignition switch ACC and P position
(2) Ignition switch ACC and except P position
(3) Ignition switch ACC and except P position (After approx. 1 second)
0
7.5 – 11
6 – 9.5
(1) Ignition switch ON and P position
(2) Depress brake pedal
(3) Except P position
0
8 – 13.5
0
B, 3 – B, 1 (P1 – P)
(1) Ignition switch ON, P position and depressing brake pedal
(2) Shift except P position under conditions above
0
9 – 13.5
B, 4 – B, 1 (P2 – P)
(1) Ignition switch ACC, P position
(2) Shift except P position under conditions above
9 – 13.5
0
A, 3 – A, 5 (IG – E)
B, 2 – B, 5 (SLS+ – SLS–)
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK SOLENOID
Disconnect the solenoid connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals.
Standard resistance: 29 – 35 Ω
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the solenoid.
5 (SLS–)
2 (SLS+)
Q09460
(c)
Apply battery positive voltage between terminals. Check
that operation noise can be heard from the solenoid.
If the solenoid does not operate, replace the solenoid.
5 (SLS–)
2 (SLS+)
Q09461
Author:
Date:
1908
AX–16
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMMK Made)
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
Disconnect the solenoid connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals.
Standard resistance: 12.5 – 16.5 Ω
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the solenoid.
1 (KLS+)
2 (E)
Q09456
(c)
Apply battery positive voltage between terminals. Check
that an operation noise can be heard from the solenoid.
If the solenoid does not operate, replace the solenoid.
1 (KLS+)
2 (E)
Q09457
3 (P1) 4 (P2)
1 (P)
Q09464
4.
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Inspect that there is continuity between each terminal.
Shift position
Tester connection
Specified value
P position (Release
button is not pushed)
1 – 3 (P – P1)
Continuity
P position (Release
button is pushed)
1 – 3 (P – P1)
1 – 4 (P – P2)
Continuity
R, N, D, 2, L position
1 – 4 (P – P2)
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Author:
Date:
1909
AX–17
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
AX03G–01
COMPONENTS
14 (145, 10)
Air Cleaner Assembly
Engine Hood
14 (145, 10)
Starter
Hold Down Clamp
Cruise Control Actuator
RH Drive Shaft
Torque Converter
Clutch
66 (670, 48)
42 (430, 31)
39 (400, 29)
Snap Ring
Manifold Stay
Stiffener
Plate
32 (330, 24)
Battery
27 (280, 20)
TMMK
x6
42 (430, 31)
39 (400, 29)
39 (400, 29)
TMC
42 (430, 31)
Stiffener Plate
Battery Tray
LH Drive Shaft
66 (670, 48)
Snap Ring
Clip
42 (430, 31)
Shift Control Cable
Exhaust
Manifold Stay
15 (150, 11)
66 (670, 48)
Plug for Line Pressure Test
19 (195, 14)
No.1 Exhaust Pipe Support Bracket
Rear End Plate
25 (250, 18)
Oil Pan Insulator
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Q10053
Author:
Date:
1910
AX–18
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
RH Fender Apron seal
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
RR Engine Mounting
Stabilizer Bar
TMC Made : 80 (820, 59)
TMMK Made :
Green Color Bolt : 66 (670, 48)
Silver Color Bolt : 44 (450, 32)
19 (195, 14)
RH Rear
Lower Brace
10 (100, 7)
LH Engine Mounting
64 (650, 47)
39 (400, 29)
Steering Return Pipe
FR Engine Mounting
Stabilizer Bar Link
RH Front Lower Brace
181 (1,850, 134)
LH Rear Lower Brace
66 (670, 48)
32 (330, 24)
Front Suspension
Member
TMC Made : 80 (820, 59)
TMMK Made :
Green Color Bolt : 66 (670, 48)
Silver Color Bolt : 44 (450, 32)
36 (370, 27)
181 (1,850, 134)
LH Front
Lower Brace
36 (370, 27)
Front Exhaust Pipe
Gasket
62 (630, 46)
127 (1,300, 94)
80 (820, 59)
181 (1,850, 134)
56 (570, 41)
Gasket
Exhaust Pipe No.1 Support Bracket
LH Fender Apron Seal
Tie Rod End
33 (330, 24)
Exhaust Pipe
Clamp
49 (500, 36)
Cotter Pin
LH Fender Liner
33 (330, 24)
294 (3,000, 217)
Lock Nut Cap
Center Engine Under Cover
LH Fender Liner
Engine Under Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Q10054
Author:
Date:
1911
AX–19
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
AX03H–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE BATTERY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE
4.
w/ CRUISE CONTROL:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 bolts and disconnect cruise control actuator with the bracket.
(a)
(b)
Q10055
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Q00211
DISCONNECT OIL COOLER HOSE
DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
DISCONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
DISCONNECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE NO.1 AND
NO.2 CONNECTOR
DISCONNECT SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE SL CONNECTOR
10.
REMOVE 2 FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING BOLTS
Torque:
TMC made: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
TMMK made:
Green color bolt: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
Silver color bolt: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
11.
12.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT 2 GROUND CABLES
REMOVE STARTER
Disconnect the connector and remove the nut.
Remove the 2 bolts, shift cable clamp and starter.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
REMOVE 3 TRANSAXLE–TO–ENGINE BOLTS
Torque: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
Q10056
13.
Q10057
Author:
Date:
1912
AX–20
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
Q10058
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
14. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD STAY
Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust manifold stay.
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
15. REMOVE TRANSAXLE–TO–ENGINE BOLT
Torque: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
16. REMOVE ENGINE HOOD
(a) Disconnect the washer pipe.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and engine hood.
Torque: 14 N·m (145 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
17. RAISE AND SUPPORT VEHICLE SECURELY
18. REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
19. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER AND CENTER ENGINE UNDER COVER
20.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT SHIFT CONTROL CABLE
Remove the nut and disconnect the shift control cable
from the park/neutral position switch.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
Remove the clip and disconnect the shift control cable
from the bracket.
Q10059
21.
Q00251
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL FLUID DRAIN PLUG AND
GASKET
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Replace the used gasket with a new gasket.
22. DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL FLUID
23. REMOVE LH AND RH FENDER APRON SEALS
24. REMOVE LH AND RH DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–17)
Author:
Date:
1913
AX–21
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
25.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Q10060
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
REMOVE EXHAUST FRONT PIPE
Remove the 2 nuts and exhaust front pipe clamp.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust pipe No.1 support bracket.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Remove the 3 nuts.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Replace the used nuts with new ones.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts, nuts and front exhaust pipe.
Torque: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Replace the used nuts with new ones.
(e) Remove the 2 gaskets.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Replace the used gaskets with new ones.
26. REMOVE FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR BOLT
Torque:
TMC made: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
TMMK made:
Green color bolt: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
Silver color bolt: 44 N·m (450 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
Q00068
27.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING NUT
Remove the 2 grommets.
Remove the 3 nuts.
Torque: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
28.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE LEFT SIDE TRANSAXLE MOUNTING NUT
Remove the 2 grommets.
Remove the 2 nuts.
Torque: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
Q08532
Q10061
Author:
Date:
1914
AX–22
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
29.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
REMOVE STEERING GEAR HOUSING
Remove the 4 bolts, LH and RH stabilizer bar brackets
and bushings.
Torque:19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Remove the front stabilizer bar. (See page SA–48)
Remove the 2 steering gear housing mounting bolts and
nuts.
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
Q10062
30.
TIE STEERING GEAR HOUSING TO REAR ENGINE
MOUNTING BRACKET BY CORD OR EQUIVALENT
31. ATTACH ENGINE SLING DEVICE TO ENGINE HANGERS
CAUTION:
Do not attempt to hang the engine by hooking the chain to
any other part.
Q10063
32.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT FRAME ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 bolts and steering return pipe mounting
brackets.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(b)
Remove the screws and turn over the front side of the LH
and RH fender liners.
(c)
Remove the screws and turn over the rear side of LH and
RH fender liners.
Q06479
Q10041
Q10037
Author:
Date:
1915
AX–23
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
(d)
Front
(e)
33.
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
Remove the 6 bolts and 4 nuts.
Torque:
19 mm head bolt: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
14 mm head bolt: 32 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Nut: 36 N·m (370 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Remove the front frame assembly.
SUPPORT TRANSAXLE WITH A TRANSMISSION
JACK
Q10172
Rear
Q10064
TMC : Bolt
TMMK : Nut
Q10065
34. REMOVE FRONT SIDE STIFFENER PLATE
TMMK made:
Remove the nut, 2 bolts and stiffener plate.
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
TMC made:
Remove the 3 bolts and stiffener plate.
Torque: 42 N·m (430 kgf·cm, 31 ft·lbf)
35. REMOVE REAR END PLATE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No.1 exhaust pipe support bracket.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and rear end plate with oil pan insulator.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1916
AX–24
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
36.
Q10066
REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH MOUNTING BOLT
Turn the crankshaft to gain access to each bolt, remove the 6
bolts with holding the crankshaft pulley set bolt by a wrench.
Torque: 27 N·m (280 kgf·cm, 20 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
First the install black colored bolt and then the 5 other bolts.
37. REMOVE REAR SIDE STIFFENER PLATE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and manifold stay.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and stiffener plate.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
38. REMOVE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Separate the transaxle and engine, and lower the transaxle.
Author:
Date:
1917
AX–25
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
AX03I–01
INSTALLATION
1.
AT3412
CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH INSTALLATION
Using a scale and a straight edge, measure to the distance from
the installed surface to the transaxle housing.
Correct distance: 13.0 mm (0.512 in.) or more
2.
TRANSAXLE INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page
AX–19).
HINT:
After installation, check and inspect items as follows.
Fluid level (See page DI–389)
Front wheel alignment (See page SA–4)
Road test of the vehicle
Engine hood (See page BO–10)
Author:
Date:
1918
AX–26
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND DRIVE PLATE
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
AND DRIVE PLATE
SST
AX03J–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
AT0953
INSPECT ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Install SST into the inner race of the one–way clutch.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32010)
Install SST so that it fits in the notch of the converter hub
and outer race of the one–way clutch.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32020)
(c)
With the torque converter clutch standing on its side,the
clutch locks when turned counterclockwise, and rotates
freely and smoothly clockwise.
If necessary, clean the converter and retest the clutch. Replace
the converter clutch if the clutch still fails the test.
Hold
Lock
Turn
Free
AT3306
2.
MEASURE DRIVE PLATE RUNOUT AND INSPECT
RING GEAR
Set up a dial indicator and measure the drive plate runout.
Maximum runout: 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
If the runout is not within the specification or if the ring gear is
damaged, replace the drive plate. If installing a new drive plate,
note the orientation of spacers and tighten the bolts.
Torque: 83 N·m (850 kgf·cm, 61 ft·lbf)
Q04237
Author:
Date:
1919
AX–27
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A140E)
–
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND DRIVE PLATE
3.
AT4184
MEASURE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SLEEVE
RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily mount the torque converter clutch to the drive
plate.
Set up a dial indicator and measure the torque converter
clutch sleeve runout.
Maximum runout: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the runout is not within the specification, try to correct by reorienting the installation of the torque converter clutch. If excessive runout cannot be corrected, replace the torque converter
clutch.
HINT:
Mark the position of the torque converter clutch to ensure the
correct installation.
(b) Remove the torque converter clutch.
Author:
Date:
1920
AX–1
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
AX03L–01
PRECAUTION
If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile communication system, refer to the precautions in the IN section.
Author:
Date:
1921
AX–2
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
AX03M–01
OPERATION
1st and Reverse
2nd Coast Brake
2nd Brake (B2)
Brake (B3)
(B1)
Forward Clutch
One–Way Clutch
Direct Clutch
(C1)
No.2 (F2)
(C2)
Planetary Gear Unit
O/D Direct Clutch (C0)
O/D Brake (B0)
One–Way Clutch
No.1 (F1)
Rear Planetary Gear
O/D One–Way Clutch
(F0)
Counter Drive
Gear
O/D Planetary Gear
Intermediate Shaft
Shift Lever
Position
Gear Position
P
Parking
R
Reverse
N
Neutral
C0
C1
C2
Input Shaft
Front Planetary Gear
B0
B1
B2
B3
F0
F1
F2
1st
D
2nd
3rd
O/D
1st
2
2nd
*3rd
L
1st
*2nd
*Down–shift only – no up–shift
: Operating
D01018
Author:
Date:
1922
AX–3
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
AX03N–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
2.
3.
(a)
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
REMOVE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Remove the bolt and vehicle speed sensor assembly.
Q05725
(b)
Vehicle Speed Sensor
(c)
4.
(a)
Driven Gear
O–Ring
Clip
Q04678
(b)
(c)
5.
6.
Remove the clip and driven gear from the vehicle speed
sensor.
Remove the O–ring from the vehicle speed sensor.
INSTALL VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Coat a new O–ring with ATF and install it to the vehicle
speed sensor.
Install the driven gear to the vehicle speed sensor and
clip.
Install the vehicle speed sensor assembly with the bolt.
Torque: 4.9 N·m (50 kgf·cm, 43 in.·lbf)
CONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
Author:
Date:
1923
AX–4
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
AX03O–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
2.
(a)
DISCONNECT DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
CONNECTOR
REMOVE DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
Remove the bolt and direct clutch speed sensor.
Q05726
(b)
3.
(a)
O–Ring
(b)
Remove the O–ring from direct clutch speed sensor.
INSTALL DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
Coat a new O–ring with ATF and install it to the direct
clutch speed sensor.
Install the direct clutch speed sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
Q04733
Author:
Date:
1924
AX–5
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP)
SWITCH
AX03P–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
DISCONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
Remove the clip from the shift control cable.
Remove the nut and control cable.
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Remove the nut, washer and transaxle control shaft lever.
Using a screwdriver, pry off the lock plate.
Remove the nut and lock plate.
Remove the 2 bolts and pull out the park/neutral position
switch.
3.
INSTALL AND ADJUST PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION
SWITCH
Temporarily install the park/neutral position switch with
the 2 bolts.
Install a new lock plate and nut.
Torque: 6.9 N·m (70 kgf·cm, 61 in.·lbf)
Stake the nut with the lock plate.
Q00229
Q06496
Q05727
(a)
(b)
(c)
Q04617
Author:
Date:
1925
AX–6
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
Neutral
Basic
Line
–
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
(d)
Adjust the park/neutral position switch.
(See page DI–438)
(e)
(f)
Install the transaxle control shaft lever and washer.
Install and torque the nut.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
(g)
Install the control cable and nut.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
Install the clip to the shift control cable.
CONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH CONNECTOR
TEST DRIVE VEHICLE
Groove
Z10304
Q04687
(h)
4.
5.
Q06496
Author:
Date:
1926
AX–7
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
AX03Q–02
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
DRAIN ATF
Using a hexagon wrench, remove the drain plug and fluid into
the suitable container.
2.
REMOVE OIL PAN AND GASKET
NOTICE:
Some fluid will remain in the oil pan.
Remove oil pan bolts, and carefully remove the pan assembly.
Discard the gasket.
AT3785
3.
EXAMINE PARTICLES IN PAN
Remove the magnets and use them to collect any steel chips.
Look at the chips and particles in the pan and magnet carefully
to anticipate what type of wear you will find in the transaxle.
Steel (magnetic): bearing, gear and plate wear
Brass (non–magnetic): bushing wear
AT0103
4.
REMOVE OIL STRAINER AND APPLY PIPE BRACKET
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and oil strainer.
NOTICE:
Be careful as oil will come out of the strainer when it is removed.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and apply pipe bracket.
D01019
Connector
5.
REMOVE OIL PIPES
Pry up both pipe ends with a large screwdriver and remove the
5 pipes.
6.
DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
Q05728
Author:
Date:
1927
AX–8
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
REMOVE DETENT SPRING AND OIL PIPE
Remove the 2 bolts and detent spring.
Remove the bolt.
Pry up the pipe with a screwdriver and remove the pipe.
D01020
8.
REMOVE MANUAL VALVE BODY
Remove the 5 bolts and manual valve body.
D01021
9.
REMOVE CONNECTOR CLAMP AND PIPE RETAINER
Remove the 2 bolts, connector clamp and pipe retainer.
D01059
10. REMOVE B3 APPLY PIPE
Pry up the pipe with a screwdriver and remove the pipe.
D01058
11.
(a)
REMOVE VALVE BODY
Remove the 9 bolts.
D01023
Author:
Date:
1928
AX–9
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
(b)
12.
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
Disconnect the throttle cable from the cam and remove
the valve body.
REMOVE 2ND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
OR0038
13.
(a)
REMOVE SOLENOID VALVES
Remove the 3 bolts, shift solenoid valve No.1 and No.2
with the retainer.
NOTICE:
When removing solenoid, do not use a screwdriver, etc. to
pry up the solenoid.
(b) Remove the O–rings from the shift solenoid valve No.1
and No.2.
Q05643
(c)
(d)
Remove the bolt and shift solenoid valve SL.
Remove the O–ring from the shift solenoid valve SL.
(e)
(f)
Remove the bolt and shift solenoid valve SLN.
Remove the O–ring from the shift solenoid valve SLN.
14.
(a)
INSTALL SOLENOID VALVES
Coat the 2 new O–rings with ATF and install it to the shift
solenoid valve SL.
Install the shift solenoid valve SL.
Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
Q05657
Q05402
(b)
(c)
Q05657
Author:
Date:
1929
AX–10
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
(d)
(e)
(f)
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
Coat the 2 new O–rings with ATF and install it to the shift
solenoid valve SLN.
Install the shift solenoid valve SLN.
Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
Q05402
(g)
(h)
(i)
15.
Coat the 2 new O–rings with ATF and install it to the shift
solenoid valve No.1 and No.2.
Install the No.1 and No.2 solenoids.
Install and torque the 3 bolts.
Torque: 6.6 N·m (67 kgf·cm, 58 in.·lbf)
PLACE NEW 2ND BRAKE APPLY GASKET
Q05643
16.
(a)
INSTALL VALVE BODY TO TRANSAXLE CASE
While holding the cam down with your hand, slip the cable
end into the slot.
(b) Lower the valve body into place.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to entangle the solenoid wire.
OR0038
D
D
A
C
C
B
C
D01023
(c) Install and tighten the 9 bolts.
HINT:
Hand tighten the 9 bolts first, then torque with a torque wrench.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 30 mm (1.181 in.)
Bolt B: 43 mm (1.693 in.)
Bolt C: 48 mm (1.890 in.)
Bolt D: 52 mm (2.047 in.)
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
17. INSTALL B3 APPLY PIPE
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend or damage the pipe.
D01058
Author:
Date:
1930
AX–11
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
18.
(a)
(b)
B
A
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
INSTALL CONNECTOR CLAMP AND PIPE RETAINER
Install the connector clamp and pipe retainer.
Install and torque the 2 bolts.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 48 mm (1.890 in.)
Bolt B: 39 mm (1.535 in.)
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
D01059
19.
(a)
B
B
A
D01021
30
(1.18)
B
A
mm (in.)
Z19257
Connector
INSTALL MANUAL VALVE BODY
Align the manual valve with the pin on the manual shaft
lever.
(b) Lower the manual valve body into place.
(c) Hand tighten the 5 bolts first. Then, tighten them with a
torque wrench.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 22 mm (0.866 in.)
Bolt B: 37 mm (1.457 in.)
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
20. INSTALL DETENT SPRING AND OIL PIPE
(a) Place the detent springs on the manual valve body and
hand tighten the 2 bolts first. Then, tighten them with a
torque wrench.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 14 mm (0.551 in.)
Bolt B: 37 mm (1.457 in.)
Torque: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
(b) Check that the manual valve lever is touching the center
of the detent spring tip roller.
(c) Using a plastic hammer, install the pipe into the position.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend or damage the pipe.
(d) Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
21. CONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTORS
22. INSTALL OIL PIPES
Using a plastic hammer, install the pipes into the positions.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend or damage the pipes.
Q05728
Author:
Date:
1931
AX–12
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
A
23.
(a)
(b)
A
B
B
Z19256
–
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
INSTALL OIL STRAINER AND APPLY PIPE BRACKET
Install the oil strainer and apply pipe bracket.
Install and torque the 6 bolts.
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 22 mm (0.866 in.)
Bolt B: 53 mm (2.087 in.)
Torque:
Bolt A: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
Bolt B: 11 N·m (110 kgf·cm, 8 ft·lbf)
24. INSTALL MAGNETS IN PLACE
Install the 3 magnets in the indentations of the oil pan, as shown
in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the magnet does not interfere with the oil
pipes.
AT3741
25.
(a)
(b)
26.
27.
INSTALL OIL PAN AND GASKET
Install the oil pan and a new gasket.
Install and torque the 17 new bolts.
Torque: 7.8 N·m (80 kgf·cm, 69 in.·lbf)
INSTALL AND TORQUE DRAIN PLUG
Torque: 49 N·m (500 kgf·cm, 36 ft·lbf)
FILL ATF AND CHECK FLUID LEVEL
(See page DI–438)
AT3785
Author:
Date:
1932
AX–13
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
THROTTLE CABLE
THROTTLE CABLE
AX03R–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
1.
2.
REMOVE BATTERY
w/ Cruise Control:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Remove the 3 bolts and cruise control actuator.
Q09982
3.
DISCONNECT THROTTLE CABLE FROM ENGINE
Disconnect the cable from the throttle linkage.
4.
REMOVE PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX–5)
5.
REMOVE VALVE BODY
(See page AX–7)
Q00225
6.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE
Remove the bolt and retaining plate.
Pull out the cable from the transaxle case.
7.
INSTALL THROTTLE CABLE INTO TRANSAXLE
CASE
Make sure to push it in all the way.
Install the retaining plate and bolt.
Install and torque the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
INSTALL VALVE BODY
(See page AX–7)
Q00270
(a)
(b)
(c)
8.
Q00270
9.
200 mm
(7.87 in.)
0.8 – 1.5 mm (0.031–0.059 in.)
Q05731
IF THROTTLE CABLE IS NEW, STAKE STOPPER OR
PAINT MARK ON INNER CABLE
HINT:
New cables do not have a staked cable stopper.
(a) Bend the cable so there is a radius of about 200 mm (7.87
in.).
(b) Pull the inner cable lightly until slight resistance is felt, and
hold it there.
(c) Stake the stopper, 0.8–1.5 mm (0.031–0.059 in.) from the
end of outer cable.
Author:
Date:
1933
AX–14
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
10.
11.
12.
–
THROTTLE CABLE
CONNECT THROTTLE CABLE TO ENGINE
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
ADJUST THROTTLE CABLE
(See page DI–438)
INSTALL PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
(See page AX–5)
Q00225
13.
w/ Cruise Control:
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Install the cruise control actuator with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
14. INSTALL BATTERY
15. TEST DRIVE VEHICLE
Q09982
Author:
Date:
1934
AX–15
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL
DIFFERENTIAL OIL SEAL
AX03S–01
ON–VEHICLE REPAIR
SST
1.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(See page SA–25)
2.
REMOVE SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
Using SST, pull out the oil seal.
SST 09308–00010
Q00394
3.
(a)
SST
(b)
INSTALL LEFT SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
Using SST and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09223–15020, 09351–32014 (09351–32130)
Oil seal depth: 0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.02 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
Q06348
4.
(a)
(b)
5.
SST
6.
Q00238
INSTALL RIGHT SIDE GEAR SHAFT OIL SEAL
Using SST, drive in a new oil seal.
SST 09316–60010 (09316–00010)
Oil seal depth: 0 ± 0.5 mm (0 ± 0.02 in.)
Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
(See page SA–25)
CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL
(See page DI–438)
Author:
Date:
1935
AX–16
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMC Made)
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMC Made)
AX03T–01
LOCATION
Key Interlock Solenoid
Shift Lock Override Cover
Stop Light Switch
Shift Lock Override Button
Shift Lock Control Unit Assembly
D01026
Author:
Date:
1936
AX–17
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMC Made)
AX03U–02
INSPECTION
5 (IG)
1 (ACC)
4 (KLS+)
3 (E)
2 (STP)
Wire Harness Side
Q09455
Terminal
1 – 3 (ACC – E)
1.
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL UNIT ASSEMBLY
Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at each terminal.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the shift lock control unit assembly connector.
Measuring Condition
Voltage (V)
Ignition switch ACC
10 – 14
Ignition switch ON
10 – 14
2 – 3 (STP – E)
Depressing brake pedal
10 – 14
4 – 3 (KLS+ – E)
(1) Ignition switch ACC and P position
(2) Ignition switch ACC and except P position
(3) Ignition switch ACC and except P position (After approx. 1 second)
0
7.5 – 11
6 – 9.5
5 – 3 (IG – E)
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
Disconnect the solenoid connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals.
Standard resistance: 12.5 – 16.5 Ω
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the solenoid.
1 (KLS+)
2 (E)
Q09456
(c)
Apply battery positive voltage between terminals. Check
that an operation noise can be heard from the solenoid.
If the solenoid does not operated, replace the solenoid.
1 (KLS+)
2 (E)
(–)
(+)
Q09457
Author:
Date:
1937
AX–18
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMMK Made)
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMMK Made)
AX03V–01
LOCATION
Key Interlock Solenoid
Stop Light Switch
Shift Lock Override Cover
Shift Lock Override Button
Shift Lock Solenoid
Shift Lock Control Switch
Shift Lock Control ECU
D01027
Author:
Date:
1938
AX–19
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMMK Made)
AX03W–01
INSPECTION
3 (IG) 1 (ACC)
6 (STP)
Back Side
A
1 (P)
5 (E)
4 (KLS+)
4 (P2) 5 (SLS–)
1.
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL ECU
Using a voltmeter, measure voltage at each terminal.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
B
3 (P1)
2 (SLS+) Front Side
Q09459
Terminal
A, 1 – A, 5 (ACC – E)
Measuring Condition
Voltage (V)
Ignition switch ACC
10 – 14
Ignition switch ON
10 – 14
A, 6 – A, 5 (STP – E)
Depressing brake pedal
10 – 14
A, 4 – A, 5 (KLS+ – E)
(1) Ignition switch ACC and P position
(2) Ignition switch ACC and except P position
(3) Ignition switch ACC and except P position (After approx. 1 second)
0
7.5 – 11
6 – 9.5
(1) Ignition switch ON and P position
(2) Depress brake pedal
(3) Except P position
0
8 – 13.5
0
B, 3 – B, 1 (P1 – P)
(1) Ignition switch ON, P position and depress brake pedal
(2) Shift except P position under conditions above
0
9 – 13.5
B, 4 – B, 1 (P2 – P)
(1) Ignition switch ACC, P position
(2) Shift except P position under conditions above
9 – 13.5
0
A, 3 – A, 5 (IG – E)
B, 2 – B, 5 (SLS+ – SLS–)
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK SOLENOID
Disconnect the solenoid connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals.
Standard resistance: 29 – 35 Ω
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the solenoid.
5 (SLS–)
2 (SLS+)
Q09460
(c)
Apply battery positive voltage between terminals. Check
that operation.
If the solenoid does not operated, replace the solenoid noise
can be heard from the solenoid.
5 (SLS–)
2 (SLS+)
Q09461
Author:
Date:
1939
AX–20
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
SHIFT LOCK SYSTEM (TMMK Made)
3.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT KEY INTERLOCK SOLENOID
Disconnect the solenoid connector.
Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals.
Standard resistance: 12.5 – 16.5 Ω
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the solenoid.
1 (KLS+)
2 (E)
Q09456
(c)
Apply battery positive voltage between terminals. Check
that an operation noise can be heard from the solenoid.
If the solenoid does not operated, replace the solenoid.
1 (KLS+)
2 (E)
(–)
(+)
Q09457
3 (P1) 4 (P2)
1 (P)
Q09464
4.
INSPECT SHIFT LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Inspect that there is continuity between at each terminal.
Shift position
Tester connection
Specified value
P position (Release
button is not pushed)
1 – 3 (P – P1)
Continuity
P position (Release
button is pushed)
1 – 3 (P – P1)
1 – 4 (P – P2)
Continuity
R, N, D, 2, L position
1 – 4 (P – P2)
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Author:
Date:
1940
AX–21
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
AX03X–01
COMPONENTS
Engine Hood
Air Cleaner
Assembly
26 (265, 19)
13 (130, 9)
w/ Cruise Control :
Cruise Control Actuator
Shift Control
Cable Clamp
RH Drive Shaft
Starter
Snap Ring
39 (400, 29)
32 (330, 24)
41 (420, 30)
x6
48 (490, 35)
66 (670, 48)
Hold–Down
Clamp
20 (200, 15)
Exhaust Manifold
Plate
x5
Battery
Insulator
California:
Torque Converter Clutch
34 (350, 25)
Hole Cover
Exhaust manifold
Bracket
Battery
Exhaust Manifold Plate
20 (200, 14)
Shift Control Cable
Plug for Line
California:
Pressure Test
Clip
Battery Tray
Snap Ring
15 (150, 11)
34 (350, 25)
LH Drive Shaft
Exhaust manifold Bracket
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
D01057
Author:
Date:
1941
AX–22
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
RH Fender Apron Seal
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
Rear Side Engine
Mounting Insulator
Stabilizer Bar Link
Stabilizer Bar
RH Rear Lower Brace
19 (195, 14)
36 (370, 27)
32 (330, 24)
80 (820, 59)
Steering Return Pipe
10 (100, 7)
39 (400, 29)
181 (1,850, 134)
TMC Made:
80 (820, 59)
TMMK Made:
Green Color Bolt
66 (670, 48)
Silver Color Bolt
44 (450, 32)
LH Fender Apron Seal
181 (1,850, 134)
LH Rear Lower Brace
Front Side Engine
Mounting Insulator
Tie Rod End
RH Front
Lower Brace
36 (370, 27)
Lock Cap
49 (500, 36)
181 (1,850, 134)
TMC Made:
80 (820, 59)
TMMK Made:
Green Color Bolt
66 (670, 48)
Silver Color Bolt
44 (450, 32)
RH Fender Liner
48 (490, 35)
Grommet
80 (820, 59)
LH Front
Lower Brace
Cotter Pin 294 (3,000, 217)
127 (1,300, 94)
Exhaust Front Pipe
Support Bracket
62 (630, 46)
Gasket
21 (210, 15)
Gasket
Gasket
Cotter
Pin
56 (570, 41)
62 (630, 46)
33 (330, 24)
Center Engine Under Cover
Exhaust Front Pipe Support Stay
33 (330, 24)
LH Fender Liner
Engine Under Cover
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Q10282
Author:
Date:
1942
AX–23
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
AX03Y–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
REMOVE BATTERY
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
REMOVE THROTTLE CABLE FROM THROTTLE
BODY
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
4.
w/ Cruise Control:
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 bolts and disconnect cruise control actuator with the bracket.
Torque: 13 N·m (130 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
Q00225
(a)
(b)
Q09982
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
DISCONNECT GROUND CABLE
DISCONNECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
DISCONNECT DIRECT CLUTCH SPEED SENSOR
CONNECTOR
DISCONNECT PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
CONNECTOR
DISCONNECT SOLENOID CONNECTOR
Q10287
10.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT SHIFT CONTROL CABLE
Remove the nut and disconnect the shift control cable
from the park/neutral position switch.
Torque: 15 N·m (150 kgf·cm, 11 ft·lbf)
Remove the clip and disconnect the shift control cable.
Q00075
11.
REMOVE 2 ENGINE MOUNTING ABSORBER BOLTS
Torque: 48 N·m (490 kgf·cm, 35 ft·lbf)
Q10028
Author:
Date:
1943
AX–24
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
12.
REMOVE 2 FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING BOLTS
Torque:
TMC Made: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
TMMK Made:
Green color bolt: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
Silver color bolt: 44 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
13.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE STARTER AND A/T SHIFT CABLE CLAMP
Disconnect the connector and remove the nut.
Remove the 2 bolts, starter and A/T shift cable clamp.
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
14.
REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD BRACKET MOUNTING BOLT
Torque:
Except California: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
California: 34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
15.
REMOVE 5 TRANSAXLE–TO–ENGINE BOLTS AND
DISCONNECT GROUND TERMINAL
Torque: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
REMOVE ENGINE HOOD
Disconnect the washer pipe.
Remove the 4 bolts and engine hood.
Torque: 26 N·m (265 kgf·cm, 19 ft·lbf)
RAISE AND SUPPORT VEHICLE SECURELY
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 103 N·m (1,050 kgf·cm, 76 ft·lbf)
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL FLUID DRAIN PLUG AND
GASKET
Q06478
Q10286
Q06530
16.
(a)
(b)
Q10038
17.
18.
19.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Replace the used gasket with a new gasket.
20. DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL FLUID
21. REMOVE LH AND RH ENGINE SIDE COVERS
22. REMOVE LH AND RH FRONT DRIVE SHAFTS
(See page SA–25)
Author:
Date:
1944
AX–25
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
23.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER FRONT COVER AND NO.4
CENTER ENGINE UNDER COVER
24.
(a)
REMOVE EXHAUST FRONT PIPE
Remove the 2 bolts and exhaust front pipe support stay.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Remove the 4 nuts.
Torque: 62 N·m (630 kgf·cm, 46 ft·lbf)
(b)
Q10030
–
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Replace the used nuts with new once.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and nuts.
Torque: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Replace the used nuts with new once.
(d) Remove the 2 exhaust front pipe clamp bolts and exhaust
front pipe.
Torque: 33 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
(e) Remove the 3 gaskets.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Replace the used gaskets with new once.
(f)
Remove the 2 nuts, 2 bolts, exhaust front pipe support
bracket and hole cover.
Torque:
Exhaust front pipe support bracket mounting nut:
21 N·m (210 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
Hole plug mounting bolt:
20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
Q10341
25.
REMOVE FRONT SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR BOLT
Torque:
TMC Made:
80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
TMMK Made:
Green color bolt: 66 N·m (670 kgf·cm, 48 ft·lbf)
Silver color bolt: 44 N·m (440 kgf·cm, 32 ft·lbf)
Q00235
Author:
Date:
1945
AX–26
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
26.
DISCONNECT 2 OIL COOLER HOSES
27.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR SIDE ENGINE MOUNTING NUT
Remove the 2 grommets.
Remove the 4 nuts.
Torque: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
28.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE LEFT SIDE TRANSAXLE MOUNTING NUT
Remove the 2 grommets.
Remove the 2 nuts.
Torque: 80 N·m (820 kgf·cm, 59 ft·lbf)
29.
(a)
REMOVE STEERING GEAR HOUSING
Remove the 4 bolts, LH and RH stabilizer bar brackets
and bushings.
Torque: 19 N·m (195 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
Remove the front stabilizer bar.
(See page SA–47)
Remove the 2 steering gear housing mounting bolts and
nuts.
Torque: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
Q10027
Q10071
Q10034
(b)
(c)
Q10035
30.
SUPPORT STEERING GEAR HOUSING, AS SHOWN
Q10040
Author:
Date:
1946
AX–27
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
31.
Engine
Hanger
P19478
ATTACH ENGINE SLING DEVICE TO ENGINE HANGERS
(a) Install the No.2 engine hanger in the correct direction.
Part No.:
No.2 engine hanger: 12282–20020
Bolt: 91642–80825
Torque: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 14 ft·lbf)
(b) Attach the engine chain hoist to the engine hangers.
CAUTION:
Do not attempt to hang the engine by hooking the chain to
any other part.
32.
(a)
REMOVE FRONT FRAME ASSEMBLY
Remove the 2 bolts and PS reservoir pipe mounting
brackets.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
(b)
Remove the 4 screws and turn over the front side of the
LH and RH fender liners.
(c)
Remove the 2 screws and turn over the rear side of LH
and RH fender liners.
Q06479
Q10041
Q10037
Author:
Date:
1947
AX–28
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
(d)
Front
(e)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
Remove the 6 bolts and 4 nuts.
Torque:
19 mm head bolt: 181 N·m (1,850 kgf·cm, 134 ft·lbf)
14 mm head bolt: 32 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Nut: 36 N·m (370 kgf·cm, 27 ft·lbf)
Remove the front frame assembly.
Q10172
Rear
Q10064
33.
Q04660
SUPPORT TRANSAXLE WITH A TRANSMISSION
JACK
34. REMOVE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH MOUNTING BOLTS
Turn the crankshaft to gain access to each bolt, remove the 6
bolts with holding the crankshaft pulley bolt by a wrench.
Torque: 41 N·m (420 kgf·cm, 30 ft·lbf)
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
First install black colored bolt and then the 5 other bolts.
35. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD PLATE
(a) Remove the bolt, nut and exhaust manifold plate.
Torque:
Except California: 20 N·m (200 kgf·cm, 15 ft·lbf)
California: 34 N·m (350 kgf·cm, 25 ft·lbf)
Q10036
36.
REMOVE 3 LOWER TRANSAXLE–TO–ENGINE
BOLTS
Torque: 46 N·m (470 kgf·cm, 34 ft·lbf)
37. REMOVE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Separate the transaxle and engine, and lower the transaxle.
Left and lower
Z14284
Author:
Date:
1948
AX–29
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE UNIT
AX03Z–01
INSTALLATION
1.
CHECK TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH INSTALLATION
Using a scale and a straight edge, measure from the installed
surface to the transaxle housing.
Correct distance: 13.7 mm (0.539 in.) or more
AT3412
2.
TRANSAXLE INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
(See page AX–23)
HINT:
After installation, check and inspect items as follows.
Fluid level. (See page DI–438)
Front wheel alignment. (See page SA–4)
Do the road test. (See page DI–438)
Hood. (See page BO–10)
Author:
Date:
1949
AX–30
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND DRIVE PLATE
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH
AND DRIVE PLATE
AX040–01
INSPECTION
SST
1.
(a)
INSPECT ONE–WAY CLUTCH
Install SST into the inner race of the one–way clutch.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32020)
(b)
Install SST so that it fits in the notch of the converter hub
and outer race of the one–way clutch.
SST 09350–32014 (09351–32010)
AT0952
SST
AT0953
(c)
With the torque converter clutch standing on its side,the
clutch locks when turned counterclockwise, and rotates
freely and smoothly clockwise.
If necessary, clean the converter and retest the clutch.
Replace the converter if the clutch still fails the test.
Hold
Lock
Turn
Free
AT3306
2.
AT2821
MEASURE DRIVE PLATE RUNOUT AND INSPECT
RING GEAR
(a) Set up a dial indicator, and measure the drive plate runout.
(b) Check the damage of the ring gear.
Maximum runout: 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.)
If the runout is not within specification or ring gear is damaged,
replace the drive plate.
Torque: 83 N·m (850 kgf·cm, 61 ft·lbf)
Author:
Date:
1950
AX–31
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE (A541E)
–
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH AND DRIVE PLATE
3.
AT4184
MEASURE TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SLEEVE
RUNOUT
(a) Temporarily mount the torque converter clutch to the drive
plate. Set up a dial indicator and measure the torque converter clutch sleeve runout.
Maximum runout: 0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the runout is not within the specification, try to correct by reorienting the installation of the converter.
HINT:
Mark the position of the converter to ensure the correct installation.
(b) Remove the torque converter clutch.
Author:
Date:
1951
AC–1
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC0LG–02
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
DO NOT HANDLE REFRIGERANT IN AN ENCLOSED
AREA OR WEAR EYE PROTECTION
ALWAYS WEAR EYE PROTECTION
AC2810
3.
AC2811
Wrong
LO
HI
6.
Okey
LO
BE CAREFUL NOT TO GET LIQUID REFRIGERANT IN
YOUR EYES OR ON YOUR SKIN
If liquid refrigerant gets in your eyes or on your skin.
(a) Wash the area with lots of cool water.
CAUTION:
Do not rub your eyes or skin.
(b) Apply clean petroleum jelly to the skin.
(c) Go immediately to a physician or hospital for professional
treatment.
4.
NEVER HEAT CONTAINER OR EXPOSE IT TO NAKED
FLAME
5.
BE CAREFUL NOT TO DROP CONTAINER AND NOT
TO APPLY PHYSICAL SHOCKS TO IT
HI
N11084
DO NOT OPERATE COMPRESSOR WITHOUT
ENOUGH REFRIGERANT IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
If there is not enough refrigerant in the refrigerant system oil lubrication will be insufficient and compressor burnout may occur,
so that care to avoid this, necessary care should be taken.
7.
DO NOT OPEN PRESSURE MANIFOLD VALVE WHILE
COMPRESSOR IS OPERATE
If the high pressure valve is opened, refrigerant flows in the reverse direction and could cause the charging cylinder to rupture, so open and close the only low pressure valve.
8.
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVERCHARGE SYSTEM WITH
REFRIGERANT
If refrigerant is overcharged, it causes problems such as insufficient cooling, poor fuel economy, engine overheating etc.
Author:
Date:
2483
AC–2
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
9.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)
The CAMRY is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System) such as the driver airbag and passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service operations the correct sequence could
cause the SRS to unexpectedly deployed during servicing, possible the SRS may fail to operate when required. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the following item carefully, then
follow the correct procedure described in the repair manual.
Author:
Date:
2484
AC–3
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC0LI–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
Sight Glass
N20242
Item
1.
INSPECT REFRIGERANT VOLUME
Observe the sight glass on the liquid tube.
Test conditions:
Running engine at 1,500 rpm
Blower speed control switch at ”HI” position
A/C switch ON
Temperature control dial at ”COOL” position
Fully open the doors
Symptom
Amount of refrigerant
Remedy
1
Bubbles present in sight glass
Insufficient*
(1) Check for gas leakage with gas leak detector and repair if necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles disappear
2
No bubbles present in sight glass
None, sufficient or too much
Refer item 3 and 4
3
No temperature difference between compressor inlet and outlet
Empty or nearly empty
(1) Check for gas leakage with gas leak detector and repair if necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles disappear
4
Temperature between compressor inlet and
outlet is noticeably different
Correct or too much
Refer to items 5 and 6
5
Immediately after air conditioning is turned
off, refrigerant in sight glass stays clear
Too much
(1) Discharge refrigerant
(2) Evacuate air and charge proper amount
or purified refrigerant
6
When air conditioning is turned off, refrigerant foams and then stays clear
Correct
–
*: Bubbles in the sight glass with ambient temperatures higher than usual can be considered normal if cooling
is sufficient.
Author:
Date:
2485
AC–4
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
2.
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE WITH MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
This is a method in which the trouble is located by using a manifold gauge set. Read the manifold gauge pressure when the
these conditions are established.
Test conditions:
Temperature at the air inlet with the switch set
at RECIRC is 30 – 35 °C (86 – 95 °F)
Engine running at 1500 rpm
Blower speed control switch at ”HI” position
Temperature control dial on ”COOL” position
HINT:
It should be noted that the gauge indications may vary slightly
due to ambient temperature conditions.
(1) Normally functioning refrigeration system.
Gauge reading:
Low pressure side:
0.15 – 0.25 MPa (1.5 – 2.5 kgf/cm2)
High pressure side:
1.37 – 1.57 MPa (14 – 16 kgf/cm2)
I01386
Author:
Date:
2486
AC–5
AIR CONDITIONING
–
(2)
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Moisture present in refrigeration system.
Condition : Periodically cools and then fails to cool
I01387
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Probable cause
During operation, pressure on low
pressure side sometimes become
a vacuum and sometime normal
Moisture entered in refrigeration
system freezes at expansion valve
orifice and temporarily stops cycle,
but normal state is restored after a
time when the ice melts
Diagnosis
(3)
Drier oversaturated state
Moisture in refrigeration system
freezes at expansion valve orifice
and blocks circulation of refrigerant
Remedy
(1) Replace receiver
(2) Remove moisture in cycle
through repeatedly evacuating air
(3) Charge proper amount of new
refrigerant
Insufficient cooling
Condition: Insufficient cooling
I01388
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Pressure low on both low and
high pressure sides
Bubbles seen in sight glass continuously
Insufficient cooling performance
Probable cause
Gas leakage at some place in refrigeration system
Diagnosis
Insufficient refrigerant in system
Refrigerant leaking
Author:
Remedy
(1) Check for gas leakage with gas
leak detector and repair if necessary
(2) Charge proper amount of refrigerant
(3) If indicated pressure value is
near 0 when connected to gauge,
create the vacuum after inspecting
and repairing the location of the
leak
Date:
2487
AC–6
AIR CONDITIONING
(4)
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Poor circulation of refrigerant
Condition: Insufficient cooling
I01389
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Pressure low in both low and
high pressure sides
Frost on tube from receiver to
unit
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Refrigerant flow obstructed by dirt
in receiver
(5)
Receiver clogged
Remedy
Replace receiver
Refrigerant does not circulate
Condition: Does not cool (Cools from time to time in some cases)
I01449
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Vacuum indicated on low pressure side, very low pressure indicated on high pressure side
Frost or dew seen on piping before and after receiver/ drier or expansion valve
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Refrigerant flow obstructed by
moisture or dirt in refrigeration system
Refrigerant does not circulate
Refrigerant flow obstructed by
gas leakage from expansion valve
Author:
Remedy
(1) Check expansion valve
(2) Clean out dirt in expansion
valve by blowing with air
(3) Replace receiver
(4) Evacuate air and charge new
refrigerant to proper amount
(5) For gas leakage from expansion valve, replace expansion
valve
Date:
2488
AC–7
AIR CONDITIONING
–
(6)
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Refrigerant overcharged or insufficient cooling of
condenser
Condition: Insufficient cooling
I01390
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Pressure too high on both low
and high pressure sides
No air bubbles seen through the
sight glass even when the engine
rpm is lowered
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Remedy
Unable to develop sufficient performance due to excessive refrigeration system
Insufficient cooling of condenser
Excessive refrigerant in
cycle → refrigerant over charged
Condenser cooling → condenser
fins clogged of condenser fan
faulty
(1) Clean condenser
(2) Check condenser fan motor
operation
(3) If (1) and (2) are in normal
state, check amount of refrigerant
Charge proper amount of refrigerant
(7)
Air present in refrigeration system
Condition: Insufficient cooling
NOTE : These gauge indications are shown when the
refrigeration system has
been opened and the refrigerant charged without vacuum purging.
I01392
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Pressure too high on both low
and high pressure sides
The low pressure piping hot to
touch
Bubbles seen in sight glass
Probable cause
Air entered in refrigeration system
Diagnosis
Air present in refrigeration system
Insufficient vacuum purging
Author:
Remedy
(1) Check compressor oil to see if
it is dirty or insufficient
(2) Evacuate air and charge new
refrigerant
Date:
2489
AC–8
AIR CONDITIONING
(8)
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Expansion valve improperly
Condition: Insufficient cooling
I01450
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Pressure too high on both low
and high pressure sides
Frost or large amount of dew on
piping on low pressure side
Probable cause
Diagnosis
Excessive refrigerant in low
pressure piping
Expansion valve opened too
wide
Trouble in expansion valve
(9)
Remedy
Check expansion valve
Replace if defective
Defective compression compressor
Condition : Does not cool
I01393
Symptom seen in
refrigeration system
Pressure too high on low and
high pressure sides
Pressure too low on high pressure side
Probable cause
Internal leak in compressor
Diagnosis
Compression defective
Valve leaking or broken sliding
parts
Author:
Remedy
Repair or replace compressor
Date:
2490
AC–9
AIR CONDITIONING
3.
(a)
(b)
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT IDLE–UP SPEED
Warm up engine.
Inspect idle–up speed when the these conditions are established.
Warm up engine
Blower speed control switch at ”HI” position
A/C switch ON
Temperature control dial at ”COOL” position
Magnetic clutch condition
Idle–up speed
Magnetic clutch not engaged
700 ± 50 rpm
Magnetic clutch engaged
700 ± 50 rpm
If idle speed is not as specified, check ISC valve and air intake
system.
4.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
(a) Perform in these conditions:
Stop engine.
Secure good ventilation (If not the gas leak detector
may react to volatile gases witch are not refrigerant,
such as evaporated gasoline and exhaust gas.)
Repeat the test 2 or 3 times.
Make sure that there is some refrigerant remaining
in the refrigeration system.
When compressor is OFF: approx. 392 – 588 kPa
(4 – 6 kgf/ cm2, 57 – 85 psi)
(b)
Bring the gas leak detector close to the drain hose before
performing the test.
HINT:
After the blower motor stopped, leave the cooling unit for
more than 15 minutes.
Expose the gas leak detector sensor the under the drain
hose.
When bring the gas leak detector close to the drain hose,
make sure that the gas leak detector does not react to the
volatile gases.
If such reaction is unavoidable, the vehicle must be lifted up.
(c) If gas leak is not detected on the drain hose, remove the
blower resistor from the cooling unit. Then insert the gas
leak detector sensor into the unit and perform the test.
(d) Disconnect the connector and leave the pressure switch
for approx. 20 minutes. Then bring the gas leak detector
close to the pressure switch and perform the test.
(e) Bring the gas leak detector close to the refrigerant lines
and perform the test.
Author:
Date:
2491
AC–10
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC0LJ–03
EVACUATING
Quick Disconnect
Adapter
1.
Charging
Hose
2.
3.
(a)
(b)
Service Valve
N13795
CONNECT QUICK DISCONNECT ADAPTER TO
CHARGING HOSES
REMOVE CAPS FROM SERVICE VALVES ON REFRIGERANT LINES
SET ON MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
Close both hand valves of manifold gauge set.
Connect the quick disconnect adapters to the service
valves.
4.
(a)
EVACUATE AIR FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
Connect the vacuum pump adapter to the vacuum pump.
(b)
Connect the center hose of the manifold gauge set to the
vacuum pump adapter.
Open both the high and low hand valves and run the vacuum pump.
After 10 minutes or more, check that the low pressure
gauge indicates 750 mmHg (30 in. Hg) or more.
Vacuum Pump
Vacuum Pump Adapter
N13794
Manifold
Gauge
Set
(c)
(d)
HINT:
If the reading 750 mmHg (30 in. Hg) or more, close both hand
valves of manifold gauge set and stop the vacuum pump.
Check the system for leaks and repair necessary.
(e) Close both the high and low hand valves and stop the vacuum pump.
(f)
Leave the system in this condition for 5 minutes or more
and check that there is no gauge indicator.
Low Pressure
Service Valve
High Pressure
Service Valve
Vacuum Pump Adapter
N13791
Author:
Date:
2492
AC–11
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC21S–01
CHARGING
1.
INSTALL CHARGING CYLINDER
HINT:
When handling the charging cylinder, always follow the directions given in the instruction manual.
(a) Charge the proper amount of refrigerant into the charging
cylinder.
(b) Connect the center hose to the charging cylinder.
CAUTION:
Do not open both high and low hand valves of manifold
gauge set.
(c) Open the valve of charging cylinder.
(d) Press the valve core on the side of manifold gauge and
expel the air inside of the center hose.
Push
Air
Low Pressure
Service Valve
High Pressure
Service Valve
Charging Cylinder
N13793
2.
(a)
INSPECT REFRIGERATION SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
Open the high pressure hand valve and charge refrigerant.
(b) When the low pressure gauge indicates 98 kPa
(1 kgf/cm2, 14 psi) close the high pressure hand valve.
(c) Using a gas leak detector, check the system for leakage.
(d) If leak is found, repair the faulty component or connection.
CAUTION:
Use the refrigerant recovery/ recycling machine to recover
the refrigerant whenever replacing parts.
Gas Leak
Detector
N13792
Author:
Date:
2493
AC–12
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
3.
Low Pressure
Service Valve
High Pressure
Service Valve
N13790
CHARGE REFRIGERANT INTO REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
If there is no leak after refrigerant leak check, charge the proper
amount of refrigerant into refrigeration system.
CAUTION:
Never run the engine when charging the system
through the high pressure side.
Do not open the low pressure hand valve when the
system is being charged with liquid refrigerant.
(a) Open the high pressure hand valve fully.
(b) Charge specified amount of refrigerant, then close the
high pressure hand valve.
HINT:
A fully charged system is indicated by the sight glass being free
of any bubbles.
(c) Charge partially refrigeration system with refrigerant.
(1) Set vehicle in these conditions:
Running engine at 1,500 rpm
Blower speed control set at ”HI”
Temperature control set at ”MAX. COOL”
Air inlet control set at ”RECIRC”
Fully open doors (Sliding roof: closed)
(2) Open the low pressure hand valve.
CAUTION:
Do not open the high pressure hand valve.
(d)
Charge refrigerant until bubbles disappear and check the
pressure on the gauge through the sight glass.
Properly
Charged
Insufficiently
Charged
I07055
Author:
Date:
2494
AC–13
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC0LL–02
LOCATION
1MZ–FE engine:
No. 1 Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Switch
1MZ–FE engine:
No. 2 Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Switch
Compressor
Engine Room Relay Block No. 1
Magnetic Clutch Relay
(Marking: MG CLT)
Heater Main Relay
(Marking: HTR)
No. 2 Cooling Fan Relay
(Marking: FAN NO.2)
No. 3 Cooling Fan Relay
(Marking: FAN NO.3)
Condenser Fan
Fan Motor
Pressure Switch
Receiver
Condenser
Engine Room Junction Block No. 2
Engine Main Relay
(Marking: ENGINE MAIN)
No. 1 Cooling Fan Relay
(Marking: FAN NO.1)
5S–FE engine models:
Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Switch
A/C Unit
Blower Unit
5S–FE engine:
ECM (Built in A/C Amplifier)
A/C Control Assembly
A/C Switch
Blower Speed Control Switch
Mode Switch
Air Outlet Servomotor
Expansion Valve
1MZ–FE:
A/C Amplifier
Evaporator
Heater Radiator
Blower Motor
Thermistor
Author:
Blower Resistor
Z19146
Date:
2495
AC–14
AIR CONDITIONING
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
AC21T–01
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.
Symptom
Suspect Area
See page
No blower operation
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
No air temperature control
1. Engine coolant volume
2. A/C control assembly
–
AC–80
No air inlet control
1. A/C control assembly
AC–80
No air outlet control
1. HTR Fuse
2. Air outlet servomotor
3. Mode switch
–
AC–65
AC–84
No compressor operation
1. Refrigerant volume
2. A.C Fuse
3. HTR Fuse
4. Magnetic clutch relay
5. Magnetic clutch
6. Compressor
7. Pressure switch
8. Heater main relay
9. Blower speed control switch
10.A/C switch
11.*1 ECM
*2 A/C amplifier
12.Wire harness
AC–3
–
–
AC–71
AC–39
AC–39
AC–67
AC–70
AC–84
AC–84
DI–218
AC–88
–
1.
2.
3.
4.
Refrigerant volume
Condenser fan
Pressure switch
*1 ECM
*2 A/C amplifier
5. Thermistor
6. Wire harness
AC–3
AC–74
AC–67
DI–218
AC–88
AC–24
–
1. Refrigerant volume
2. Refrigerant pressure
3. Drive belt
4. Compressor lock sensor
5. Magnetic clutch
6. Compressor
7. Pressure switch
8. Thermistor
9. A/C switch
10.*1 ECM
*2 A/C amplifier
11.Wire harness
AC–3
AC–3
AC–16
AC–16
AC–39
AC–39
AC–67
AC–24
AC–84
DI–218
AC–88
–
No compressor operates intermittently
No cool air comes out
HTR Fuse
Heater main relay
Blower motor
Blower resistor
Blower speed control switch
Wire harness
Author:
–
AC–70
AC–63
AC–64
AC–84
–
Date:
2496
AC–15
AIR CONDITIONING
–
TROUBLESHOOTING
Cool air comes out only at high engine rpm
1. Refrigerant volume
2. Drive belt
3. Magnetic clutch
4. Compressor
5. Condenser
6. Condenser fan
7. Receiver
8. Expansion valve
9. Evaporator
10.Thermistor
11.Refrigerant line
12.Pressure switch
13.*1 ECM
*2 A/C amplifier
AC–3
AC–16
AC–16
AC–39
AC–52
AC–74
AC–49
AC–59
AC–30
AC–24
AC–21
AC–67
DI–218
AC–88
No engine idle–up when A/C switch ON
1. *1 ECM
*2 A/C amplifier
2. Wire harness
DI–218
AC–88
–
Blinking of A/C indicator
1. *1 ECM
*2 A/C amplifier
2. Thermistor
3. Compressor
DI–218
AC–88
AC–24
AC–39
1.
2.
3.
4.
A/C Fuse
Mode switch
A/C switch
*1 ECM
*2 A/C amplifier
5. Wire harness
–
AC–84
AC–84
DI–218
AC–88
–
1. Engine coolant volume
2. A/C control assembly
3. Heater radiator
–
AC–80
AC–57
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
–
–
AC–72
AC–72
AC–72
AC–74
AC–67
AC–92
AC–92
AC–92
–
A/C indicator does not lights up when turn mode switch to DEF.
position
No warm air comes out
No condenser fan operation
CDS FAN Fuse
Engine main relay
Cooling fan relay No. 1
Cooling fan relay No. 2
Cooling fan relay No. 3
Condenser fan motor
Pressure switch
*1 Engine coolant temp. switch
*2 No. 1 Engine coolant temp. switch
9. *2No. 2 Engine coolant temp. switch
10.Wire harness
*1: 5S–FE Engine Models
*2: 1MZ–FE Engine Models
Author:
Date:
2497
AC–16
AIR CONDITIONING
–
DRIVE BELT
DRIVE BELT
AC0LM–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT DRIVE BELT’S INSTALLATION CONDITION
Check that the drive belt fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
Correct
Wrong
CH0086
2.
INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION
Using a belt tension gauge, check the drive belt tension.
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 165 ± 26 lbf
Used belt: 110 ± 11 lbf
Generator
Crankshaft Pulley
Compressor
DENSO
N17028
HINT:
Borroughs
”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used less than
5 minutes on a running engine.
”Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
After installing the drive belt, check that it fits properly in
the ribbed grooves.
N01881
Author:
Date:
2498
AC–17
AIR CONDITIONING
–
DRIVE BELT
AC0LN–02
5S–FE:
REMOVAL
Pivot Bolt
Adjusting Bolt
Drive Belt
1MZ–FE:
Pivot Bolt
Adjusting Lock
Bolt
Drive Belt
Adjusting Lock
Bolt
REMOVE DRIVE BELT
(a) Loosen the pivot bolt and adjusting lock bolt.
Torque:
5S–FE:
Pivot bolt: 52 N·m (530 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
Adjusting lock bolt: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
1MZ–FE:
Pivot bolt: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
Adjusting lock bolt: 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
(b) Loosen the drive belt tension by adjusting bolt and remove the drive belt.
Adjusting Bolt
Z19189
Author:
Date:
2499
AC–18
AIR CONDITIONING
–
DRIVE BELT
AC0LO–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–17).
Author:
Date:
2500
AC–19
AIR CONDITIONING
–
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
AC0LP–02
SET ON
1.
CONNECT CHARGING HOSES TO MANIFOLD
GAUGE SET
Tighten the nuts by hand.
CAUTION:
Do not connect the wrong hoses.
2.
CONNECT QUICK DISCONNECT ADAPTERS TO
CHARGING HOSES
Tighten the nuts by hand.
3.
CLOSE BOTH HAND VALVES OF MANIFOLD GAUGE
SET
4.
REMOVE CAPS FROM SERVICE VALVES ON REFRIGERANT LINE
Low Pressure
Charging Hose
High Pressure
Charging hose
N20312
5.
CONNECT QUICK DISCONNECT ADAPTERS TO SERVICE VALVES
HINT:
Push the quick disconnect adapter onto the service valve, then
slide the sleeve of the quick disconnect adapter downward to
lock it.
Sleeve
N04392
Author:
Date:
2501
AC–20
AIR CONDITIONING
–
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
AC0LQ–02
SET OFF
1.
2.
N06553
CLOSE BOTH HAND VALVES OF MANIFOLD GAUGE
SET
DISCONNECT QUICK DISCONNECT ADAPTERS
FROM SERVICE VALVES ON REFRIGERANT LINE
HINT:
Slide the sleeve of the quick disconnect adapter upward to unlock the adapter and remove it from the service valve.
3.
INSTALL CAPS TO SERVICE VALVES ON REFRIGERANT LINE
Author:
Date:
2502
AC–21
AIR CONDITIONING
–
REFRIGERANT LINE
REFRIGERANT LINE
AC0LR–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECTION HOSE AND TUBE CONNECTIONS FOR LOOSENESS
2.
INSPECT HOSES AND TUBES FOR LEAKAGE
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant.
Author:
Date:
2503
AC–22
AIR CONDITIONING
–
REFRIGERANT LINE
AC0LS–02
LOCATION
Liquid Tube
Suction Tube
Piping Clamp
32 (330, 24)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.·lbf)
Liquid Tube
10 (100, 7)
14 (140, 10)
10 (100, 7)
Suction Hose
Discharge Hose
10 (100, 7)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
I07049
Author:
Date:
2504
AC–23
AIR CONDITIONING
–
REFRIGERANT LINE
AC0LT–03
REPLACEMENT
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
2.
REPLACE FAULTY TUBE OR HOSE
NOTICE:
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or dirt out of the system.
3.
TIGHTEN JOINT OF BOLT OR NUT TO SPECIFIED TORQUE
NOTICE:
Connections should not be torqued tighter than the specified torque.
Part tightened
N·m
kgf·cm
ft·lbf
Receiver x Liquid tube
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Condenser x Discharge hose
10
100
7
Condenser x Liquid tube
14
140
10
Compressor x Discharge hose
10
100
7
Compressor x Suction hose
10
100
7
Expansion valve x Evaporator
5.4
55
48 in.·lbf
Suction line (Piping joint)
32
330
24
Suction line (Block joint)
10
100
7
4.
EVACUATE AIR FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM AND CHARGE WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount : 800 ± 50g (28.22 ± 1.76 oz.)
5.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant.
6.
INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
Author:
Date:
2505
AC–24
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC21U–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Remove glove compartment (See page BO–75).
(b)
Remove the blower resistor.
(1) Disconnect the connector.
(2) Remove the 2 screws and blower resistor.
(c) Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage.
If there is leakage, check the tightening torque at the joints or
check the evaporator.
(d) Install the blower resistor.
(e) Install the lower No. 2 finish panel (See page BO–81).
N20296
2.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT THERMISTOR RESISTANCE
Disconnect the connector.
Measure resistance between terminals.
Standard resistance: 1,500 Ω at 25°C (77°F)
If resistance is not as specified, replace the thermistor.
N20294
Author:
Date:
2506
AC–25
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC21V–01
COMPONENTS
Instrument Panel
Reinforcement
No. 1 Brace
No. 2 Brace
Water Hose
Piping Clamp
Suction Tube
Liquid Tube
A/C Unit
Piping Clamp
O–ring
O–ring
Blower Motor
Air Duct (Foot)
Air Duct (Rear Foot)
Non–reusable part
Connector Bracket
Author:
Date:
I07050
2507
AC–26
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
Heater Protector
Heater Radiator
Pipe
Packing
O–ring
O–ring
Heater Radiator
Heater Case
Grommet
Plate
Packing
Tube and Accessory
x13
5.4 (55, 48)
Expansion Valve
O–ring
Air Outlet Servomotor
Water Seal
O–ring
5.4 (55, 48)
Thermistor
Holder
Air Duct (Foot)
Plate
Drain Hose
Insulator
Evaporator
Heater Case
N·m (kgf·cm, in:lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
I07051
Author:
Date:
2508
AC–27
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC21W–01
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Evacuate air from refrigeration system.
Charge system with refrigerant and inspect for leakage of refrigerant.
Specified amount: 800 ± 50 g (28.22 ± 1.76 oz.)
2.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT FROM RADIATOR
HINT:
It is not necessary to drain out all the coolant.
3.
(a)
(b)
DISCONNECT WATER HOSE FROM HEATER RADIATOR PIPES
Using pliers, grip the claws of the hose clip and slide the
hose clip along the hose.
Disconnect the water hose.
N20288
Heater Radiator Pipe
Water Hose
Marking
Upper
45 ± 10°
LH
RH
Hose Clip
Lower
N20237
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following items.
Push the water hose onto the heater radiator pipe as far
as ridge on the pipe and install the hose clip.
Install the hose clip in a position, as shown in the illustration.
4.
REMOVE BLOWER UNIT (See page AC–35)
5.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL AND REINFORCEMENT (See page BO–75)
6.
(a)
DISCONNECT LIQUID AND SUCTION TUBES
Using SST, remove the 2 piping clamps.
SST 09870–00015 (Suction tube)
09870–00025 (Liquid tube)
I09160
Author:
Date:
2509
AC–28
AIR CONDITIONING
(1)
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
Inert SST to piping clamp.
HINT:
Confirm the direction of the piping clamp claw and SST using
the illustration showing on the caution label.
SST
I03838
Push
SST
(2) Push down SST and release the clamp lock.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to deform the tubes, when pushing SST.
(3) Pull SST slightly and push the release lever, then remove the piping clamp with SST.
(4) Remove the piping clamp from SST.
(b) Disconnect the both tubes.
Pull
SST
Release
Lever
I03839
NOTICE:
Do not use tools like screwdriver to remove the tube.
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or
dirt out of the system.
Disconnect the tube
using hand
Screw
Driver
Tube
I06919
Correct
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Lubricate 4 new O–rings with compressor oil and install
the tubes.
After connection, check the fitting for claw of the piping
clamp.
Wrong
Gap
I06878
7.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE A/C UNIT
Disconnect the connector.
Slide the floor carpet backward.
Remove the rear heater duct.
Remove the 2 nuts and A/C unit.
N20281
Author:
Date:
2510
AC–29
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC21X–01
DISASSEMBLY
N20287
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
3.
REMOVE AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR
Release the claw and pull out the plate.
Remove the 3 screws and servomotor.
REMOVE HEATER RADIATOR
Remove the 3 screws and 3 plates.
Remove the 2 clips and heater radiator pipes.
Pull out the heater radiator.
REMOVE THESE FOOT AIR DUCT LH
4.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE EXPANSION VALVE
Remove piping clamp.
Remove the packings.
Using a hexagon wrench (5.0 mm, 0.20 in.), remove the
2 bolts and separate the expansion valve and evaporator.
N20283
Water Seal
Insurator
x13
Plate
Evaporator
N20243
5.
REMOVE EVAPORATOR
(a) Remove the grommet from the evaporator.
(b) Using a knife, cut off each packings.
HINT:
Do not reuse the packing.
(c) Remove the 13 screws and separate the heater cases,
then remove the evaporator and water seal.
(d) Release the 4 claws and remove the plate from the evaporator.
6.
PEEL OFF THE WATER SEAL FROM HEATER UNIT
7.
REMOVE THERMISTOR
Pull out the thermistor with the holders.
N20293
Author:
Date:
2511
AC–30
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC21Y–01
INSPECTION
1.
CHECK EVAPORATOR FINS FOR BLOCKAGE
If the fins are clogged, clean them with compressed air.
NOTICE:
Never use water to clean the evaporator.
2.
CHECK FITTING FOR CRACKS OR SCRATCHES
Repair as necessary.
3.
(a)
Thermometer
Ice
INSPECT THERMISTOR RESISTANCE
Place the thermistor in cold water, and while changing the
temperature of water, measure resistance at the connector and at the same time, measure temperature of water
with a thermometer.
10 cm
(0.39 in.)
Thermistor
(Ω)
5,000
4,500
4,000
3,500
3,000
2,500
2,000
1,500
1,000
500
0
0
32
Ohmmeter
I03338
(b) Compare the 2 readings on the chart.
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the thermistor.
5
41
10
50
15
59
20
68
25(°C)
77(°F)
Z04352
Author:
Date:
2512
AC–31
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC0LX–02
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL THERMISTOR TO EVAPORATOR
2.
INSTALL EVAPORATOR
(a) Install the plate to the evaporator.
(b) Install the evaporator on the insulator.
(c) Connect the heater case with the 13 screws.
NOTICE:
The packing for water seal should be replaced, with a new
one when the A/C unit is reassembled.
(d) Install the 2 new packings.
(e) Install the grommet to evaporator.
HINT:
If evaporator is replaced, add compressor oil to the compressor.
Add 40 – 50 cc (1.4 – 1.7 fl.oz.)
Compressor oil: ND – OIL 8 or equivalent
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N21046
Packing Paper
INSTALL EXPANSION VALVE
Lubricate 2 new O–rings with compressor oil and install
the tubes.
Install the liquid tube and suction tube on the expansion
valve.
Using a knife, cut off packing paper of packing while peel
off the paper, as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Leave the packing paper untaped on the tube side so that the
installation bolt hole for remains visible.
(d) Apply new packing.
N21045
NOTICE:
Do not overtape the packing beyond the expansion valve
edge.
N21044
Author:
Date:
2513
AC–32
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
(e)
N20283
Lubricate 2 new O–rings with compressor oil and install
the expansion valve.
(f)
Install the expansion valve with the tubes to evaporator
with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
When installing the expansion valve, take care so that the
packing is not jammed with the evaporator.
(g) Peel off the remaining packing paper and apply the packing to expansion valve.
4.
INSTALL HEATER RADIATOR
(a) Install the heater radiator to heater case.
(b) Install the heater radiator pipe with 2 clips.
(c) Install the 3 clamps with the 3 screws.
5.
(a)
(b)
Pin
INSTALL MODE SERVOMOTOR
Install the servomotor with the 3 screws.
Insert the drain of the plate to the pin and install plate.
Pin
N20245
Author:
Date:
2514
AC–33
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC0LY–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–27).
Author:
Date:
2515
AC–34
AIR CONDITIONING
–
BLOWER UNIT
BLOWER UNIT
AC0LZ–02
COMPONENTS
Connector Bracket
Glove Compartment
ECM
Air Inlet Damper
Control Cable
Cowl Side Trim
Blower Unit
1MZ–FE engine:
A/C Amplifier
Foot Air Duct
Front Door
Inside Scuff
Plate
No.2 Lower Cover
Blower Resistor
Connecter
Blower Motor Connector
Blower Unit Case
Blower Resistor
Blower Motor
Z19018
Author:
Date:
2516
AC–35
AIR CONDITIONING
–
BLOWER UNIT
AC0M0–02
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE PLATE LH
3.
REMOVE NO. 2 LOWER COVER
4.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
5.
REMOVE ECM
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and ECM.
6.
DISCONNECT AIR INLET DAMPER CONTROL CABLE
HINT:
At the in time of installation, please refer to following item.
After connection, inspect the air inlet control lever operation.
(See page AC–87).
7.
REMOVE A/C AMPLIFIER.
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Release the 2 claws and pull out the amplifier.
8.
REMOVE CONNECTOR BRACKET SET SCREWS
9.
REMOVE BLOWER UNIT
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Disconnect the thermistor connector clamp.
(c) Remove the 2 screws, bolt and nut, then remove the blower unit.
Author:
Date:
2517
AC–36
AIR CONDITIONING
–
BLOWER UNIT
AC0M1–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE BLOWER MOTOR
Remove the 3 screws and blower motor.
2.
REMOVE BLOWER RESISTOR
Remove the 2 screws and blower resistor.
Author:
Date:
2518
AC–37
AIR CONDITIONING
–
BLOWER UNIT
AC0M2–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page AC–36).
Author:
Date:
2519
AC–38
AIR CONDITIONING
–
BLOWER UNIT
AC0M3–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–35).
Author:
Date:
2520
AC–39
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC
CLUTCH
AC0M4–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT COMPRESSOR FOR METALLIC SOUND
Start engine.
Check if there is a metallic sound from the compressor
when the A/C switch is on.
If metallic sound is heard, replace the compressor assembly.
2.
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE
See ”ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION” of AIR CONDITIONING
SYSTEM on page AC–3.
3.
Ω
N01143
INSPECT COMPRESSOR LOCK SENSOR RESISTANCE
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2.
Standard resistance: 65 – 125 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F)
If resistance is not as specified, replace the compressor assembly.
4.
INSPECT VISUALLY FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT FROM SAFETY SEAL
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant.
If there is any leakage, replace the compressor assembly.
5.
CHECK FOR LEAKAGE OF GREASE FROM CLUTCH
BEARING
6.
CHECK FOR SIGNS OF OIL ON PRESSURE PLATE OR
ROTOR
7.
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH BEARING FOR NOISE
(a) Start engine.
(b) Check for abnormal noise from near the compressor
when the A/C switch is OFF.
If abnormal noise is being emitted, replace the magnetic clutch.
8.
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH OPERATION
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
4 and the negative (–) lead to the body ground.
(c) Check that the magnetic clutch is energized.
If operation is not as specified, replace the magnetic clutch.
N01150
Author:
Date:
2521
AC–39
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC
CLUTCH
AC0M4–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a)
(b)
INSPECT COMPRESSOR FOR METALLIC SOUND
Start engine.
Check if there is a metallic sound from the compressor
when the A/C switch is on.
If metallic sound is heard, replace the compressor assembly.
2.
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE
See ”ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION” of AIR CONDITIONING
SYSTEM on page AC–3.
3.
Ω
N01143
INSPECT COMPRESSOR LOCK SENSOR RESISTANCE
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2.
Standard resistance: 65 – 125 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F)
If resistance is not as specified, replace the compressor assembly.
4.
INSPECT VISUALLY FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT FROM SAFETY SEAL
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant.
If there is any leakage, replace the compressor assembly.
5.
CHECK FOR LEAKAGE OF GREASE FROM CLUTCH
BEARING
6.
CHECK FOR SIGNS OF OIL ON PRESSURE PLATE OR
ROTOR
7.
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH BEARING FOR NOISE
(a) Start engine.
(b) Check for abnormal noise from near the compressor
when the A/C switch is OFF.
If abnormal noise is being emitted, replace the magnetic clutch.
8.
INSPECT MAGNETIC CLUTCH OPERATION
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
4 and the negative (–) lead to the body ground.
(c) Check that the magnetic clutch is energized.
If operation is not as specified, replace the magnetic clutch.
N01150
Author:
Date:
2521
AC–40
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AC0M5–02
COMPONENTS
5S–FE engine :
O–Ring
10 (100, 7)
Suction Hose
10 (100, 7)
O–Ring
Discharge Hose
25 (250, 18)
Compressor
1MZ–FE engine :
56 (570, 41)
Generator
Drive Belt
O–Ring
10 (100, 7)
Discharge Hose
Compressor
Bracket
Drive Belt
10 (100, 7)
O–Ring
Suction Hose
25 (250, 18)
18 (185, 13)
Compressor
25 (250, 18)
25 (250, 18)
25 (250, 18)
Pressure Plate
Rotor
Drive Belt Adjusting
Bar Bracket
Stator
Compressor
Shim
13.2 (135, 9)
N·m (kgf·cm, ft·lbf) : Specified torque
Non–reusable part
Snap Ring
I03331
Author:
Date:
2522
AC–41
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AC0M6–02
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
RUN ENGINE AT IDLE SPEED WITH A/C ON FOR
APPROX.10 MINUTES
STOP ENGINE
DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
REMOVE DRIVE BELT
(See page AC–17)
6.
N20277
1MZ–FE engine models:
REMOVE SUCTION HOSE
(a) Remove the suction hose clamping bolt.
(b) Disconnect the wire harness clamp.
(c) Loosen the nut and bolts and remove the suction hose.
NOTICE:
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or dirt
out of the system.
7.
1MZ–FE engine models:
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE
Remove the bolt and disconnect the hose.
NOTICE:
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or dirt
out of the system.
8.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
1MZ–FE engine models:
REMOVE GENERATOR
Disconnect the generator connector.
Remove the nut, and disconnect the generator wire.
Disconnect the wire harness from the clip.
Remove the pivot bolt, plate washer, adjusting lock bolt
and generator.
P19978
Author:
Date:
2523
AC–42
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
9.
5S–FE engine models:
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE AND SUCTION HOSES
Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect both hoses.
NOTICE:
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or dirt
out of the system.
5S–FE
N20261
10.
5S–FE
(a)
(b)
5S–FE engine models:
REMOVE COMPRESSOR
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 bolts and compressor.
N20240
11.
1MZ–FE
(a)
(b)
1MZ–FE engine models:
REMOVE COMPRESSOR
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 bolts, nut and drive belt adjusting bar
bracket.
Z19152
(c)
1MZ–FE
Remove the 3 bolts and compressor.
Z19149
Author:
Date:
2524
AC–43
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AC0M7–02
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
REMOVE PRESSURE PLATE
Using SST and a socket wrench, remove the shaft bolt.
SST 07112–76060
Torque: 13.2 N·m (135 kgf·cm, 9 ft·lbf)
(b)
Install SST on the pressure plate.
SST 07112–66040
(c)
Using SST and socket wrench, remove the pressure
plate.
SST 07112–66040, 07112–76060
(d)
Remove the shims from the pressure plate.
2.
(a)
REMOVE ROTOR
Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 07114–84020
SST
AC0943
SST
AC0944
SST
AC0945
Shim
Pressure
Plate
AC0946
SST
AC0947
Author:
Date:
2525
AC–44
AIR CONDITIONING
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
NOTICE:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following
item.
The snap ring should be installed so that beveled side
faces up.
Snap Ring
R–Shape
–
Rotor
Compressor
N20013
(b) Using a plastic hammer, tap the rotor off the shaft.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the pulley when tapping on the rotor.
AC1743
3.
(a)
REMOVE STATOR
Disconnect the stator lead wire from the compressor
housing.
(b)
Using SST, remove the snap ring.
SST 07114–84020
AC1744
SST
AC0950
NOTICE:
At the time of reassembly, please refer to the following
item.
The snap ring should be installed so that its beveled side
faces up.
R–Shape
Snap Ring
Stator
Compressor
N20012
Author:
Date:
2526
AC–45
AIR CONDITIONING
(c)
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
Remove the stator.
Stator
AC0951
Author:
Date:
2527
AC–46
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AC0M8–02
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly
(See page AC–43).
Dial Indicator
N04963
AFTER REASSEMBLY, CHECK MAGNETIC CLUTCH
CLEARANCE
(a) Set the dial indicator to the pressure plate of the magnetic
clutch.
(b) Connect the magnetic clutch lead wire to the positive (+)
terminal of the battery.
(c) Check the clearance between the pressure plate and rotor when connecting the negative (–) terminal to the battery.
Standard clearance:
0.5 ± 0.15 mm (0.020 ± 0.0059 in.)
If the clearance is not within the standard clearance, adjust the
clearance using shims to obtain the standard clearance.
Shim thickness:
0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
0.3 mm (0.012 in.)
0.5 mm (0.020 in.)
Author:
Date:
2528
AC–47
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
AC0M9–02
INSTALLATION
1.
(a)
(b)
2.
(a)
5S–FE engine models:
INSTALL COMPRESSOR
Install the compressor with 3 bolts.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Connect the connector.
1MZ–FE engine models:
INSTALL COMPRESSOR
Install the compressor with 3 bolts.
Torque: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(b)
(A)
(B)
N20259
Install the drive belt adjusting bar bracket with 2 bolts and
nut.
Torque:
Bolt (A): 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
Bolt (B): 18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Nut: 25 N·m (250 kgf·cm, 18 ft·lbf)
(c) Connect the connector.
3.
5S–FE engine models:
CONNECT DISCHARGE AND SUCTION HOSE
Connect the both hoses with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Hoses should be connected immediately after the caps
have been removed.
HINT:
Lubricate 2 new O–rings with compressor oil and install the
tubes.
4.
1MZ–FE engine models:
INSTALL GENERATOR
(a) Mount generator on the generator bracket with the pivot
bolt and adjusting lock bolt. Do not tighten the bolts yet.
(b) Connect the generator connector.
(c) Connect the generator wire with the nut.
Author:
Date:
2529
AC–48
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COMPRESSOR AND MAGNETIC CLUTCH
5.
1MZ–FE engine models:
CONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE
Connect the discharge hose with the bolt.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Hoses should be connected immediately after the caps
have been removed.
HINT:
Lubricate a new O–ring with compressor oil and install the tube.
6.
INSTALL SUCTION HOSE
(a) Install the suction hose and tighten the bolt and nut.
Torque:
Piping joint: 32 N·m (330 kgf·cm, 24 ft·lbf)
Block joint: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Lubricate 2 new O–rings with compressor oil and install the
hose.
(b) Install the suction hose clamping bolt.
(c) Connect the wire harness clamp.
7.
INSTALL AND CHECK DRIVE BELT
(See page AC–18, AC–16)
8.
CONNECT NEGATIVE (–) TERMINAL CABLE TO BATTERY
9.
EVACUATE AIR FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
AND CHARGE SYSTEM WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount: 800 ± 50 g (28.22 ± 1.76 oz.)
10. INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant.
If there is leakage, check the tightening torque at the joints.
11. INSPECT A/C OPERATION
Author:
Date:
2530
AC–49
AIR CONDITIONING
–
RECEIVER
RECEIVER
AC0MA–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT FITTINGS FOR LEAKAGE
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage.
If there is leakage, check the tightening torque at the joints.
Author:
Date:
2531
AC–50
AIR CONDITIONING
–
RECEIVER
AC0MB–02
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Evacuate air from refrigeration system.
Charge system with refrigerant and inspect for leakage of refrigerant.
Specified amount: 800 ± 50 g (28.22 ± 1.76 oz.)
2.
REMOVE RADIATOR UPPER SUPPORT SEAL
N20279
3.
DISCONNECT 2 LIQUID TUBES FROM RECEIVER
Remove the 2 bolts and both tubes.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or dirt
out of the system.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Lubricate 2 new O–rings with compressor oil and install the
tubes.
4.
REMOVE RECEIVER
(a) Remove the holder bolt and pull out receiver downward.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
If receiver was replaced, add compressor oil to compressor.
Add 20 cc (0.71 fl.oz.)
Compressor oil: ND–OIL 8 or equivalent
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and holder.
Author:
Date:
2532
AC–51
AIR CONDITIONING
–
RECEIVER
AC0MC–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–50).
Author:
Date:
2533
AC–52
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER
CONDENSER
AC0MD–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CONDENSER FINS FOR BLOCKAGE OR DAMAGE
If the fins are clogged, wash them with water and dry with compressed air.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the fins.
If the fins are bent, straighten them with a screwdriver or pliers.
2.
INSPECT CONDENSER AND FITTINGS FOR LEAKAGE
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant.
If there is leakage, check the tightening torque at the joints.
Author:
Date:
2534
AC–53
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER
AC0ME–02
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Evacuate air from refrigeration system.
Charge system with refrigerant and inspect for leakage of refrigerant.
Specified amount: 800 ± 50 g (28.22 ± 1.76 oz.)
2.
REMOVE UPPER RADIATOR SUPPORTS
3.
REMOVE RECEIVER AND HOLDER
(See page AC–50)
I03836
4.
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE
Loosen the nut and disconnect the discharge hose.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or dirt
out of the system.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Lubricate a new O–ring with compressor oil and install the tube.
5.
REMOVE LIQUID TUBE
Loosen the nut and remove the liquid tube.
Torque: 14 N·m (140 kgf·cm, 10 ft·lbf)
NOTICE:
Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or dirt
out of the system.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Lubricate a new O–ring with compressor oil and install the tube.
Author:
Date:
2535
AC–54
AIR CONDITIONING
6.
(a)
(b)
(c)
N20451
–
CONDENSER
REMOVE CONDENSER
Remove the 2 nuts from condenser upper mountings.
Push the radiator toward the engine.
Push the condenser toward the radiator and pull it upward.
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
If condenser is replaced, add compressor oil to the compressor.
Add 40–50 cc (1.4–1.7 fl.oz.)
Compressor oil: ND–OIL 8 or equivalent
Author:
Date:
2536
AC–55
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER
AC0MF–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–53).
Author:
Date:
2537
AC–56
AIR CONDITIONING
–
HEATER RADIATOR
HEATER RADIATOR
AC21Z–01
REMOVAL
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT FROM RADIATOR
HINT:
It is not necessary to drain out all the coolant.
2.
DISCONNECT WATER HOSES FROM A/C UNIT
(See page AC–27)
3.
REMOVE NO. 1 LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
4.
REMOVE LH INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL
5.
(a)
REMOVE HEATER RADIATOR
Release the 3 claws and pull out the heater protector.
(b)
Remove the 3 screws 3 plate.
(c)
Remove the 2 screws and 2 clamps and disconnect the
2 heater radiator pipes.
(d)
Remove the heater radiator.
N20692
I09156
I09155
I09154
Author:
Date:
2538
AC–57
AIR CONDITIONING
–
HEATER RADIATOR
AC0MK–01
INSPECTION
INSPECT FINS FOR BLOCKAGE
If the fins are clogged, clean them with compressed air.
Author:
Date:
2539
AC–58
AIR CONDITIONING
–
HEATER RADIATOR
AC0ML–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–56).
Author:
Date:
2540
AC–59
AIR CONDITIONING
–
EXPANSION VALVE
EXPANSION VALVE
AC0MM–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK QUANTITY OF GAS DURING REFRIGERATION CYCLE
2.
SET ON MANIFOLD GAUGE SET (See page AC–19)
3.
RUN ENGINE
Run the engine at 1,500 rpm for at least 5 minutes.
Then check that the high pressure reading is 1.37 – 1.57 MPa (14 – 16 kgf/cm2, 199 – 228 psi).
4.
CHECK EXPANSION VALVE
If the expansion valve is faulty, the low pressure reading will drop to 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi).
HINT:
When the low pressure drops to 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), check the receiver’s IN and OUT sides is no temperature difference.
Author:
Date:
2541
AC–60
AIR CONDITIONING
–
EXPANSION VALVE
AC220–01
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
DISCONNECT LIQUID AND SUCTION TUBES FROM
A/C UNIT (See page AC–27)
REMOVE BLOWER UNIT (See page AC–35)
4.
REMOVE EXPANSION VALVE
(a) Remove the piping clamp.
(b) Ply out the packing.
HINT:
Do not reuse the packing.
(c) Using a hexagon wrench, remove the 2 bolts and separate the expansion valve and evaporator.
Expansion Valve
N20246
Author:
Date:
2542
AC–61
AIR CONDITIONING
–
EXPANSION VALVE
AC0MO–02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL LIQUID TUBE AND SUCTION TUBE TO EXPANSION VALVE
HINT:
Lubricate 4 new O–rings with compressor oil and install the
tubes.
2.
(a)
INSTALL NEW PACKING ON EXPANSION VALVE
Cut off packing paper and peel off the packing paper, as
shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Leave the packing paper untaped on the tube side so that the
installing bolt hole for remains visible.
N21046
(b)
Apply the packing on the expansion valve.
N21045
NOTICE:
Do not overtape the packing beyond the expansion valve
edge.
N21044
Author:
Date:
2543
AC–62
AIR CONDITIONING
–
EXPANSION VALVE
3.
(a)
N20246
INSTALL EXPANSION VALVE
Install the expnaion valve with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
NOTICE:
When installing the expansion valve, take care so that the
packing is not jammed with the evaporator.
HINT:
Lubricate 2 new O–rings with compressor oil and install O–rings
on the expansion valve.
(b) Peel off the remaing packing paper and apply the packing
to expansion valve.
4.
INSTALL BLOWER UNIT (See page AC–38)
5.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–81)
6.
CONNECT LIQUID TUBE AND SUCTION TUBES TO
A/C UNIT (See page AC–33)
7.
EVACUATE AIR FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
AND CHARGE SYSTEM WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount: 800 ± 50 g (28.22 ± 1.76 oz.)
8.
INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant.
If there is leakage, check the tightning torque at the joints.
Author:
Date:
2544
AC–63
AIR CONDITIONING
–
BLOWER MOTOR
BLOWER MOTOR
AC221–01
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–75)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE BLOWER MOTOR
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 screws and blower motor.
N20295
2
1
3.
INSPECT BLOWER MOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 2 and
the negative (–) lead to terminal 1, then check that the motor operations smoothly.
If operation is not as specified, replace the blower motor.
N16762
4.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL BLOWER MOTOR
Install the blower motor with the 3 screws.
Connect the connector.
5.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–81)
N20295
Author:
Date:
2545
AC–64
AIR CONDITIONING
–
BLOWER RESISTOR
BLOWER RESISTOR
AC222–01
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–75)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE BLOWER RESISTOR
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 2 screws and blower resistor.
3.
INSPECT BLOWER RESISTOR RESISTANCE
N20296
2
4
1
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
2–4
Constant
Approx. 0.38 Ω
2–3
Constant
Approx. 1.12 Ω
1–3
Constant
Approx. 1.74 Ω
If resistance is not as specified, replace the blower resistor.
3
Z19190
4.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL BLOWER RESISTOR
Install the blower resistor with the 2 screws.
Connect the connector.
5.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–81)
N20296
Author:
Date:
2546
AC–65
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR
AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR
AC223–01
INSPECTION
1.
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
REMOVE LH INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL
(See page BO–75)
3.
(a)
REMOVE SERVOMOTOR
Release the claw and pull out the plate.
(b)
(c)
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the 3 screws and servomotor.
4.
(a)
INSPECT SERVOMOTOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
6 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 7.
Connect the negative (–) lead from the battery to each terminal and check that the shaft rotates at each position, as
shown in the illustration.
N20287
N20278
FOOT/DEF. FOOT BI–LEVEL
40° 53°
DEF.
36°
36°
(b)
0 ± 2.5°
FACE
6 5
7
Connected terminal
Position
5
DEF.
4
FOOT/DEF.
3
FOOT
2
B/L
1
FACE
If operation is not as specified, replace the servomotor.
1
4
3
2
Z19151
Author:
Date:
2547
AC–66
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR OUTLET SERVOMOTOR
5.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL SERVOMOTOR
Install servomotor with the 3 screws.
Connect he connector.
(c)
Install the plate, then restraint the claw.
(d)
Insert the drain of plate to the lever pin.
6.
7.
INSTALL LH INSTRUMENT LOWER PANEL
INSTALL NO. 1 LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
(See page BO–81)
N20278
N20287
Pin
Pin
N20245
Author:
Date:
2548
AC–67
AIR CONDITIONING
–
PRESSURE SWITCH
PRESSURE SWITCH
AC0N2–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
2.
3.
SET ON MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
(See page AC–19)
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR FROM PRESSURE
SWITCH
RUN ENGINE AT APPROX. 1,500 RPM
N20291
4.
Magnetic clutch control
Low pressure side
High pressure side
ON (Continuity)
196 kPa
3, 140 kPa
(2.0 kgf/cm2, 28 psi) (32.0kgf/cm 2, 455 psi)
OFF (No Continuity)
Z13470
5.
Condenser fan control
ON
(Continuity)
150 kPa
(15.5 kgf/cm2, 220 psi)
1, 226 kPa
(12.5 kgf/cm2, 178 psi)
Magnetic clutch control:
INSPECT PRESSURE SWITCH OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to terminal 4 and negative (–) lead to terminal 1.
(b) Check continuity between terminals when refrigerant
pressure is changed, as shown in the illustration.
If operation is not as specified, replace the pressure switch.
OFF
(No Continuity)
Z13471
Condenser fan control:
INSPECT PRESSURE SWITCH OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to terminal 2 and negative (–) lead to terminal 3.
(b) Check continuity between terminals when refrigerant
pressure is changed, as shown in the illustration.
If operation is not as specified, replace the pressure switch.
6.
STOP ENGINE AND REMOVE MANIFOLD GAUGE
SET
7.
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO PRESSURE SWITCH
Author:
Date:
2549
AC–68
AIR CONDITIONING
–
PRESSURE SWITCH
AC0N3–02
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION
SYSTEM
HINT:
At the time of installation, please refer to the following item.
Evacuate air from refrigeration system.
Charge system with refrigerant and inspect for leakage of refrigerant.
Specified amount: 800 ± 50 g (28.22 ± 1.76 oz.)
N20292
2.
REMOVE PRESSURE SWITCH FROM LIQUID TUBE
Disconnect the connector and remove the pressure switch.
Torque: 10 N·m (100 kgf·cm, 7 ft·lbf)
HINT:
Lock the switch mount on the tube with an open end
wrench, being careful not to deform the tube, and remove
the switch.
At the time of installation, please refer to the following
item.
Lubricate a new O–ring with the compressor oil and install
the switch.
Author:
Date:
2550
AC–69
AIR CONDITIONING
–
PRESSURE SWITCH
AC0N4–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–68).
Author:
Date:
2551
AC–70
AIR CONDITIONING
–
HEATER MAIN RELAY
HEATER MAIN RELAY
AC224–01
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE HEATER MAIN RELAY FROM ENGINE
ROOM RELAY BLOCK NO. 1
2.
INSPECT HEATER MAIN RELAY
(Marking: HTR RLY) CONTINUITY
Heater Main
Relay
I09189
3
4
5
3
4
1
1
5
2
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–3
2–4
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 3.
4–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
2
Z19533
Author:
Date:
2552
AC–71
AIR CONDITIONING
–
MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY
MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY
AC225–01
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE MAGNETIC CLUTCH RELAY FROM ENGINE
ROOM RELAY BLOCK NO. 1
2.
INSPECT HEATER MAIN RELAY
(Marking: MG CLT RLY) CONTINUITY
Magnetic Clutch
Relay
I09189
3
1
5
3
5
1
2
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
2
Z18060
Author:
Date:
2553
AC–72
AIR CONDITIONING
–
COOLING FAN RELAY
COOLING FAN RELAY
AC226–01
INSPECTION
1.
REMOVE NO. 1 COOLING FAN RELAY FROM ENGINE
ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK NO. 2
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 COOLING FAN RELAY FROM ENGINE
ROOM RELAY BLOCK NO. 1
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 COOLING FAN RELAY FROM ENGINE
ROOM RELAY BLOCK NO. 1
4.
INSPECT NO. 1 COOLING FAN RELAY
(Marking: FAN RLY NO. 1) CONTINUITY
No. 1 Cooling
Fan Relay
S05390
No. 2 Cooling
Fan Relay
S05387
No. 3 Cooling
Fan Relay
S05388
1
3
4
3
4
1
2
2
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
3–4
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–4
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Z12319
5.
2
3
4
1
5
INSPECT NO. 2 COOLING FAN RELAY
(Marking: FAN RLY NO. 2) CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
3–4
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
N23635
Author:
Date:
2554
AC–73
AIR CONDITIONING
6.
3
1
5
3
5
1
2
–
COOLING FAN RELAY
INSPECT NO. 3 COOLING FAN RELAY
(Marking: FAN RLY NO. 3) CONTINUITY
Condition
Tester connection
Specified condition
Constant
1–2
Continuity
Apply B+ between
terminals 1 and 2.
3–5
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
2
Z18060
Author:
Date:
2555
AC–74
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER FAN
CONDENSER FAN
AC0N6–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CONDENSER FAN OPERATION
Inspect the fan operation, as shown in the chart below.
Test conditions:
Ignition switch ON
Blower speed control switch position ”HI”
A/C switch ON
Condition
Fan operation (Fan speed)
Engine coolant temperature
83°C (181°F) or below
Not rotate
Engine coolant temperature
98°C (208°F) or above
Rotate
Refrigerant pressure is less than
1,520 kPa (15.5 kgf/cm2, 220 psi)
Not rotate (Low Speed)
Refrigerant pressure is 1,520 kPa
(15.5 kgf/cm2, 220 psi) or above
Rotate (High Speed)
If operation is not as specified, proceed next inspection.
2
2.
(a)
(b)
1
(c)
A
N20290
INSPECT CONDENSER FAN MOTOR OPERATION
Disconnect the fan connector.
Connect the battery and ammeter to the connector, as
shown in the illustation.
Check that the fan rotates smoothly, and then check that
the reading on the ammeter.
Specified amperage: 10.1 ± 1.8 A at 20 °C (68 °F)
If operation is not as specified, replace the fan motor.
If operation is as specified, check the pressure
switch, cooling fan relays and engine coolant temp.
switch.
Author:
Date:
2556
AC–75
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER FAN
AC0N7–02
COMPONENTS
Upper Radiator Hose
Condenser Fan Connector
Condenser Fan
Fan Shroud
Fan
Fan Motor
Non–reusable part
Clip
Z19147
Author:
Date:
2557
AC–76
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER FAN
AC0N8–02
REMOVAL
1.
1MZ–FE engine models only:
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT FROM RADIATOR
HINT:
It is not necessary to drain out all the coolant.
2.
1MZ–FE engine models only:
DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE
3.
REMOVE CONDENSER FAN
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and fan.
Author:
Date:
2558
AC–77
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER FAN
AC0N9–02
DISASSEMBLY
Protrusion
P19301
1.
REMOVE FAN
Remove the clip and fan.
NOTICE:
When removing the clip and fan, do not apply too much
force to the motor shaft. And do not scratch the motor
shaft.
HINT:
Install a new clip from the side opposite the protrusion on the
fan.
2.
REMOVE FAN MOTOR
(a) Disconnect the lead wire from the fan shroud.
(b) Remove the 3 screws and fan motor.
Author:
Date:
2559
AC–78
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER FAN
AC0NA–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page AC–77).
Author:
Date:
2560
AC–79
AIR CONDITIONING
–
CONDENSER FAN
AC0NB–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–76).
Author:
Date:
2561
AC–80
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC0NC–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT A/C CONTROL DIAL AND LEVER OPERATION
Move the control dial and lever left and right and check for stiffness and binding through the full range of the
levers.
Author:
Date:
2562
AC–81
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC0ND–02
COMPONENTS
LH Lower Instrument
Panel
Center Cluster Finish Panel
A/C Control Assembly
No.1 Lower Finish
Panel
Glove Compartment
Cowl Side Trim
Cowl Side Trim
Front Door Inside
Scuff Plate
Front Door Inside Scuff Plate
Air Inlet Damper Control Cable
Blower Speed Control
Switch
Air Inlet Control Lever
Mode Switch
A/C Switch
Heater Control Base
Defogger Switch
Heater Control
Name Sheet
Heater Control Knob
Z19017
Author:
Date:
2563
AC–82
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC0NE–02
REMOVAL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM LH AND RH
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE SCUFF PLATE LH
AND RH
REMOVE NO. 2 LOWER COVER
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
REMOVE NO. 1 LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
REMOVE LH LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
REMOVE CENTER CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
DISCONNECT A/C CONTROL CABLES
Air Mix Damper
Control Cable
Air Inlet Damper
Control Cable
N20304
9.
REMOVE A/C CONTROL ASSEMBLY
Remove the 4 screws and pull out the A/C control assembly,
then disconnect the connector.
N20289
Author:
Date:
2564
AC–83
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC0NF–02
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE A/C SWITCH AND DEFOGGER SWITCH
Using a screwdriver, release the claw and pull out the switch backward.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE HEATER CONTROL KNOBS
3.
REMOVE HEATER CONTROL CABLE
4.
REMOVE BLOWER SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Remove the 2 screws and pull out the switch.
5.
REMOVE MODE SWITCH
Remove the 2 screws and pull out the switch.
6.
REMOVE HEATER CONTROL NAME SHEET
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Using a screwdriver, release the 4 claws and heater control name sheet.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Author:
Date:
2565
AC–84
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC0NG–02
2
OFF
INSPECTION
1
1.
(a)
INSPECT A/C INDICATOR OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1.
(b) Push the A/C button in and then check that the indicator
lights up.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
ON
N19466
4
2
1
ON
OFF
2.
(a)
INSPECT DIMMING OPERATION
Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
2 and the negative (–) lead to terminal 1 while press the
switch.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from battery to terminal 4
and then check that the indicator dims.
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
N19484
3.
OFF
INSPECT A/C SWITCH CONTINUITY
Condition/ Circuit
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
–
No continuity
ON
2–5
Continuity
Illumination circuit
3–4
Continuity
ON
N19467
4.
M1
M2
Switch continuity:
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Illumination circuit:
If continuity is not as specified, replace the bulb.
INSPECT BLOWER SPEED CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Position/ Circuit
Tester connection
Specified condition
OFF
–
No continuity
LO
1–3
Continuity
M1
1–3–4
Continuity
M2
1–3–8
Continuity
HI
1–3–5
Continuity
Illumination circuit
6–7
Continuity
N19464
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Author:
Date:
2566
AC–85
AIR CONDITIONING
5.
N20257
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
INSPECT MODE SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch position
Tester connection
Specified condition
FACE
1–6
Continuity
B/L
1–5
Continuity
FOOT
1–4
Continuity
FOOT/DEF.
1–3
Continuity
DEF.
1–2
7–8
Continuity
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
6.
INSPECT REAR DEFOGGER SWITCH OPERATION
(See page BE–56)
Author:
Date:
2567
AC–86
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC0NH–01
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly (See page AC–83).
Author:
Date:
2568
AC–87
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY
AC0NI–02
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal
(See page AC–82).
1.
AFTER INSTALLATION INSPECT A/C CONTROL LEVER AND DIAL OPERATION
Move the control dial and lever left and right and check fro stiffness and binding through the full range of the lever and dial.
If there is stiffness or binding, proceed next step.
2.
ADJUST A/C CONTROL CABLES
(a) Set A/C control assembly in these conditions:
(1) Air inlet control lever in ”FRESH” position
(2) Temperature control dial in ”MAX. COOL” position.
Fresh
(b)
Adjust air inlet control cable.
(1) Pull out the inner of air inlet cable and hit the link of
blower unit on the link stopper.
(2) Set the cable connector to lever pin and clamp the
cable outer.
(c)
Adjust air mix control cable.
Set the cable connector to air mix link pin on left side of
A/C unit and clamp the cable outer on.
Clamp
N21047
Cool
Clamp
N20239
Author:
Date:
2569
AC–88
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC0NJ–02
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
Wire harness side:
1.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–75)
2.
(a)
INSPECT AMPLIFIER CIRCUIT
Disconnect the amplifier connector and inspect the connector on wire harness side, as shown in the chart below.
Test conditions:
Ignition switch ON
Blower speed switch HI
Temperature control lever Max. Cool
Z13472
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
5 – Ground
Constant
Continuity
9 – 13
Evaporator temperature at 25°C (77°F)
Approx. 1.5 kΩ
14 – 13
Constant
65 – 125 Ω at 25°C (77°F)
8 – Ground
A/C switch ON
Battery positive voltage
8 – Ground
A/C switch OFF
No voltage
8 – Ground
Mode switch DEF. position
Battery positive voltage
10 – Ground
A/C switch ON
Below 4.0 V
10 – Ground
A/C switch OFF
No voltage
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the amplifier with a new
one. If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
Author:
Date:
2570
AC–89
AIR CONDITIONING
(b)
From back side:
Z13473
Tester connection
–
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
Connect the connector to amplifier and inspect wire harness side connector from the back side, as shown in the
chart below.
Test conditions:
Running engine at idle speed
Blower speed switch HI
A/C switch ON
Temperature control lever Max Cool
Set on manifold gauge set
Condition
Specified condition
1 – Ground
Magnetic clutch is not engaged
Below 1.0 V
1 – Ground
Magnetic clutch is engaged
No voltage
7 – Ground
Magnetic clutch is not engaged
Below 1.0 V
7 – Ground
Magnetic clutch is engaged
Battery positive voltage
2 – Ground
Refrigerant pressure 196 – 1,340 kPa
Battery positive voltage
2 – Ground
Refrigerant pressure
less than 196 or more than 3,140 kPa
No voltage
12 – Ground
Refrigerant pressure 196 – 1,340 kPa
Below 1.0 V
12 – Ground
Refrigerant pressure
less than 196 or more than 3,140 kPa
Battery positive voltage
12 – Ground
Engine coolant temp. 83°C (181°F) or below
Battery positive voltage
12 – Ground
Engine coolant temp. 93°C (199°F) or above
Below 1.0 V
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the amplifier with a new
one. If the circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
Author:
Date:
2571
AC–90
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC0NK–02
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT
(See page BO–75)
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE A/C AMPLIFIER
Disconnect the connector.
Release the 2 claws and pull out the amplifier.
N20285
Author:
Date:
2572
AC–91
AIR CONDITIONING
–
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC0NL–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal (See page AC–90).
Author:
Date:
2573
AC–92
AIR CONDITIONING
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SWITCH
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE (ECT) SWITCH
AC227–01
INSPECTION
1.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT FROM RADIATOR
HINT:
It is not necessary to drain out all the coolant.
2.
(a)
(b)
5S–FE:
REMOVE ECT SWITCHES
Disconnect the connector.
Remove the ECT switch.
ECT Switch
P15233
1MZ–FE:
No. 2 ECT Switch
No. 1 ECT Switch
P19584
3.
P01924
P01924
5S–FE engine:
INSPECT ECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that no continuity exists between the terminals when the coolant temperature is
above 93°C (199°F).
If continuity exists, replace the switch.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that continuity exists between
the terminals when the coolant temperature is below
83°C (181°F).
If no continuity exists, replace the switch.
4.
1MZ–FE engine:
INSPECT No. 1 SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that no continuity exists between the terminals when the coolant temperature is
above 98°C (208°F).
If continuity exists, replace the switch.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that continuity exists between
the terminals when the coolant temperature is below
88°C (190°F).
If no continuity exists, replace the switch.
Author:
Date:
2574
AC–93
AIR CONDITIONING
–
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SWITCH
5.
P06722
5S– FE:
1MZ–FE engine:
INSPECT No. 2 SWITCH CONTINUITY
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that no continuity exists between the terminal and switch body when the coolant
temperature is above 93°C (199°F).
If continuity exists, replace the switch.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that continuity exists between
the terminals when the coolant temperature is below
83°C (181°F).
If no continuity exists, replace the switch.
6.
INSTALL ECT SWITCHES
(a) Install the ECT switch.
HINT:
Lubricate a new O–ring with soapy water and install the switch.
(b) Connect the connector.
ECT Switch
P15233
1MZ–FE:
No. 2 ECT Switch
No. 1 ECT Switch
P19584
Author:
Date:
2575
CH–1
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
CHARGING SYSTEM
CHARGING SYSTEM
CH02U–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
CAUTION:
Check that the battery cables are connected to the
correct terminals.
Disconnect the battery cables when the battery is given a quick charge.
Do not perform tests with a high voltage insulation resistance tester.
Never disconnect the battery while the engine is running.
1.
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
Maintenance–Free Battery:
If under the lower level, replace the battery (or add distilled water if possible). Check the charging system.
Except Maintenance–Free Battery:
If under the lower level, add distilled water.
2.
Except Maintenance–Free Battery:
CHECK BATTERY SPECIFIC GRAVITY
Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity:
1.25 – 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
If the specific gravity is less than specification, charge the battery.
Except Maintenance–Free Battery
Z11577
3.
Maintenance–Free Battery Voltmeter
Z11556
Maintenance–Free Battery:
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) After having driven the vehicle and in the case that 20
minutes have not passed after having stopped the engine, turn the ignition switch ON and turn on the electrical
system (headlight, blower motor, rear defogger etc.) for
60 seconds to remove the surface charge.
(b) Turn the ignition switch OFF and turn off the electrical systems.
(c) Measure the battery voltage between the negative (–)
and positive (+) terminals of the battery.
Standard voltage: 12.5 – 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the battery.
Author:
Date:
1748
CH–2
CHARGING (5S–FE)
CHARGED
DARK EYE
CHARGING SYSTEM
HINT:
Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
4.
CHECK BATTERY TERMINALS, FUSIBLE LINK AND
FUSES
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or corroded.
If the terminals are corroded, clean the terminals.
(b) Check the fusible link, H–fuses, M–fuse and fuses for
continuity.
Maintenance–Free Battery
Type A
GREEN EYE
–
CLEAR EYE or
LIGHT YELLOW
DISCHARGED ADD WATER
Type B
Blue
OK
White
Red
Charging Insufficient
Necessary Water
Z18811
5.
(a)
INSPECT DRIVE BELTS
Visually check the drive belt for excessive wear, frayed
cords etc.
If any defect has been found, replace the drive belt.
HINT:
Cracks on the rib side of a drive belt are considered acceptable.
If the drive belt has chunks missing from the ribs, it should be
replaced.
Z00015
DENSO
Borroughs
Z00038
CORRECT
WRONG
CH0086
(b)
Using a belt tension gauge, measure the belt tension.
Belt tension gauge:
DENSO BTG–20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No. BT–33–73F
Drive belt tension:
w/ A/C
New belt
Used belt
165 ± 25 lbf
110 ± 10 lbf
w/o A/C
New belt
Used belt
125 ± 25 lbf
95 ± 20 lbf
If the belt tension is not as specified, adjust it.
HINT:
”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used less than
5 minutes on a running engine.
”Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
After installing a belt, check that it fits properly in the
ribbed grooves.
Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has not
slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the pulley.
Author:
Date:
1749
CH–3
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
CHARGING SYSTEM
After installing a new belt, run the engine for about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
6.
VISUALLY CHECK GENERATOR WIRING AND
LISTEN FOR ABNORMAL NOISES
(a) Check that the wiring is in good condition.
(b) Check that there is no abnormal noise from the generator
while the engine is running.
7.
CHECK CHARGE WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT
(a) Warm up the engine and then turn it off.
(b) Turn off all accessories.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ”ON”. Check that the charge warning light is lit.
(d) Start the engine. Check that the light goes off.
If the light does not go off as specified, troubleshoot the charge
light circuit.
Ammeter
Battery
Disconnect Wire
from Terminal B
Voltmeter
B
Generator
Z03473
8.
INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITHOUT LOAD
HINT:
If a battery/generator tester is available, connect the tester to
the charging circuit as per manufacturer’s instructions.
(a) If a tester is not available, connect a voltmeter and ammeter to the charging circuit as follows:
(1) Disconnect the wire from terminal B of the generator, and connect it to the negative (–) tester probe
of the ammeter.
(2) Connect the positive (+) tester probe of the ammeter to terminal B of the generator.
(3) Connect the positive (+) tester probe of the voltmeter to terminal B of the generator.
(4) Ground the negative (–) tester probe of the voltmeter.
(b) Check the charging circuit as follows:
With the engine running from idling to 2,000 rpm, check
the reading on the ammeter and voltmeter.
Standard amperage: 10 A or less
Standard voltage: 13.5 – 15.1 V
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard voltage, replace
the voltage regulator.
Author:
Date:
1750
CH–4
CHARGING (5S–FE)
Terminal F
P14433
–
CHARGING SYSTEM
If the voltmeter reading is less than standard voltage, check the
voltage regulator and generator as follows:
With terminal F grounded, start the engine and
check the voltmeter reading of terminal B.
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard voltage, replace the voltage regulator.
If the voltmeter reading is less than standard voltage, check the generator.
9.
INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITH LOAD
(a) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the high
beam headlights and place the heater blower switch at
”HI”.
(b) Check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 30 A or more
If the ammeter reading is less than the standard amperage, repair the generator.
HINT:
If the battery is fully charged, the indication will sometimes be
less than standard amperage.
Author:
Date:
1751
CH–5
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
GENERATOR
CH02V–03
COMPONENTS
Adjusting Lock Bolt
Generator Wire
Rubber Cap
Pivot Bolt
Generator
Connector
Wire Clamp
Generator
Drive Belt
S05342
Front Bearing
Rotor
Pulley
Bearing Cover
Bearing Cover
Drive End Flame (Starter)
Rectifier Holder
Generator Washer
Bearing Cover
Rear Bearing
Seal Plate
Brush Holder
Terminal Insulator
Rubber Insulator
Wire Clip
Voltage Regulator
Brush Holder Cover
Rectifier End Flame
Rear End Cover
Plate Terminal
Non–reusable part
S05076
Author:
Date:
1752
CH–6
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH02W–03
REMOVAL
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
DISCONNECT CONNECTOR AND WIRE FROM
GENERATOR
Disconnect the wire clamp from the wire clip on the rectifier end frame.
Disconnect the generator connector.
Remove the rubber cap and nut, and disconnect the generator wire.
B02375
2.
(a)
w/ A/C
Pivot Bolt
Adjusting
Bolt
Adjusting
Lock
Bolt
(b)
(c)
w/o A/C
(d)
REMOVE GENERATOR
Loosen the adjusting lock bolt (w/ A/C), adjusting bolt and
pivot bolt.
Torque:
Pivot bolt: 52 N·m (530 kgf·cm, 38 ft·lbf)
Adjusting lock bolt (w/ A/C) or adjusting bolt (w/o A/C)
18 N·m (185 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
Remove the drive belt.
Remove the adjusting lock bolt (w/ A/C) or adjusting bolt
(w/o A/C) and pivot bolt.
Remove the generator.
Pivot Bolt
Adjusting
Lock Bolt
B02376
B02377
B02693
Author:
Date:
1753
CH–7
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH02X–01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR END COVER
Remove the nut and terminal insulator.
Remove the bolt, 3 nuts, plate terminal and end cover.
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE BRUSH HOLDER AND VOLTAGE
REGULATOR
Remove the brush holder cover from the brush holder.
Remove the 5 screws, brush holder and voltage regulator.
Remove the seal plate from the rectifier end frame.
3.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE RECTIFIER HOLDER
Remove the 4 screws and rectifier holder.
Remove the 4 rubber insulators.
4.
(a)
REMOVE PULLEY
Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST (B)
clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820–63010
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Check that SST (A) is secured to the rotor shaft.
Z18635
Z18636
B02378
Turn
SST (A)
(b)
SST (B)
P13597
(c)
(d)
Mount SST (C) in a vise.
Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley nut to
SST (C).
SST (B)
SST (C)
Insert
P10834
Author:
Date:
1754
CH–8
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
(e)
SST (C)
SST (A)
Turn
To loosen the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
To prevent damage to the rotor shaft, do not loosen the
pulley nut more than one–half of a turn.
(f)
Remove the generator from SST (C).
P10827
Turn
(g)
(h)
Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
Remove the pulley nut and pulley.
5.
(a)
REMOVE RECTIFIER END FRAME
Remove the 4 nuts and wire clip.
(b)
Using SST, remove the rectifier end frame.
SST 09286–46011
Remove the generator washer from the rotor.
REMOVE ROTOR FROM DRIVE END FRAME
SST (A)
SST (B)
P13598
S05070
SST
(c)
6.
P13490
Author:
Date:
1755
CH–9
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH02Y–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT ROTOR
Check the rotor for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the slip rings.
Standard resistance: 2.7 – 3.1 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the rotor.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
CH0784
(b)
Check the rotor for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the slip ring and rotor.
If there is continuity, replace the rotor.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
CH0783
(c) Check that the slip rings are not rough or scored.
If rough or scored, replace the rotor.
(d) Using vernier calipers, measure the slip ring diameter.
Standard diameter: 14.2 – 14.4 mm (0.559 – 0.567 in.)
Minimum diameter: 12.8 mm (0.504 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the rotor.
CH1023
2.
(a)
INSPECT STATOR (DRIVE END FRAME)
Check the stator for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the coil leads.
If there is no continuity, replace the drive end frame assembly.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
P13482
(b)
Check the stator for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the coil lead and drive end frame.
If there is continuity, replace the drive end frame assembly.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
P13565
Author:
Date:
1756
CH–10
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
3.
INSPECT BRUSHES
Using vernier calipers, measure the exposed brush length.
Standard exposed length: 10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum exposed length: 1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
If the exposed length is less than minimum, replace the brush
holder assembly.
Length
P13535
4.
(a)
Ohmmeter
Positive (+)
Terminal
Rectifier
Terminal
P13568
Ohmmeter
Negative (–)
Terminal
P13566
INSPECT RECTIFIERS (RECTIFIRE HOLDER)
Check the positive (+) rectifire.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, connect one tester probe to the
positive (+) terminal and the other to each rectifier
terminal.
(2) Reverse the polarity of the tester probes and repeat
step (a).
(3) Check that one shows continuity and the other
shows no continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the rectifier holder.
(b) Check the negative (–) rectifire.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, connect one tester probe to
each negative (–) terminal and the other to each
rectifier terminal.
(2) Reverse the polarity of the tester probes and repeat
step (a).
(3) Check that one shows continuity and the other
shows no continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the rectifier holder.
5.
INSPECT BEARING
Check the bearing is not rough or worn.
If necessary, replace the bearing. (See page CH–11)
Author:
Date:
1757
CH–11
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH02Z–01
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
REPLACE FRONT BEARING
Remove the 4 screws, bearing retainer and bearing.
(b)
Using a socket wrench and press, press out the bearing.
(c)
Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00500)
Install the bearing retainer with the 4 screws.
Torque: 3.0 N·m (31 kgf·cm, 27 in.·lbf)
CH0827
Socket Wrench
P00100
SST
(d)
Downward
P13479
2.
(a)
REPLACE REAR BEARING
Using SST, remove the bearing cover (outside) and bearing.
SST 09820–00021
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the fan.
SST
N00581
(b)
(c)
Remove the bearing cover (inside).
Place the bearing cover (inside) on the rotor.
P13567
Author:
Date:
1758
CH–12
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
(d)
Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09820–00030
(e)
Using SST, push in the bearing cover (outside).
SST 09285–76010
SST
N00578
SST
P00074
Author:
Date:
1759
CH–13
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH030–01
REASSEMBLY
Pulley
1.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL ROTOR TO DRIVE END FRAME
Place the rectifier end frame on the pulley.
Install the rotor to the rectifier end frame.
2.
(a)
INSTALL RECTIFIER END FRAME
Place the generator washer on the rotor.
(b)
Using a 29 mm socket wrench and press, slowly press in
the rectifier end frame.
(c)
Install the wire clip and 4 nuts.
Torque:
Nut A: 4.5 N·m (46 kgf·cm, 40 in.·lbf)
Nut B: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
3.
(a)
INSTALL PULLEY
Install the pulley to the rotor shaft by tightening the pulley
nut by hand.
Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST (B)
clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820–63010
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Check that SST (A) is secured to the pulley shaft.
P01364
Z18637
29 mm
Socket
Wrench
P13487
B
A
A
A
Z19213
Turn
(b)
SST (A)
(c)
SST (B)
P13597
Author:
Date:
1760
CH–14
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
(d)
(e)
Mount SST (C) in a vise.
Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley nut to
SST (C).
(f)
(g)
To torque the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 110.5 N·m (1,125 kgf·cm, 81 ft·lbf)
Remove the generator from SST (C).
(h)
Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
SST (C)
P04210
SST (C)
Turn
SST (A)
P04395
Turn
SST (A)
SST (B)
P13598
4.
INSTALL RECTIFIER HOLDER
(a) Install the 4 rubber insulators on the lead wires.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the rubber insulators installation direction.
Inside
S05075
(b)
Push
Install the rectifier holder while pushing it with the 4
screws.
Torque: 2.9 N·m (30 kgf·cm, 26 in.·lbf)
S05074
Author:
Date:
1761
CH–15
CHARGING (5S–FE)
5.
(a)
–
GENERATOR
INSTALL VOLTAGE REGULATOR AND BRUSH
HOLDER
Place the seal plate on the rectifier end frame.
Z18638
(b)
Upward
Place the voltage regulator and brush holder on the rectifier end frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the holder installation direction.
(c) Install the 5 screws.
Torque: 2.0 N·m (20 kgf·cm, 18 in.·lbf)
S05461
(d)
Place the brush holder cover on the brush holder.
6.
(a)
INSTALL REAR END COVER
Install the end cover and plate terminal with the bolt and
3 nuts.
Torque:
Nut: 4.4 N·m (45 kgf·cm, 39 in.·lbf)
Bolt: 3.9 N·m (39 kgf·cm, 35 in.·lbf)
(b)
Install the terminal insulator with the nut.
Torque: 4.1 N·m (42 kgf·cm, 36 in.·lbf)
CHECK THAT ROTOR ROTATES SMOOTHLY
Z18640
Z18635
7.
S05069
Author:
Date:
1762
CH–16
CHARGING (5S–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH031–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page CH–6)
Author:
Date:
1763
CH–1
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
CHARGING SYSTEM
CHARGING SYSTEM
CH01D–01
ON–VEHICLE INSPECTION
CAUTION:
Check that the battery cables are connected to the
correct terminals.
Disconnect the battery cables when the battery is
given a quick charge.
Do not perform tests with a high voltage insulation
resistance tester.
Never disconnect the battery while the engine is
running.
1.
CHECK BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
Check the electrolyte quantity of each cell.
(1) Maintenance–Free Battery:
If under the lower level, replace the battery (or add
distilled water if possible). Check the charging system.
(2) Except Maintenance–Free Battery:
If under the lower level, add distilled water.
2.
Except Maintenance–Free Battery:
CHECK BATTERY SPECIFIC GRAVITY
Check the specific gravity of each cell.
Standard specific gravity: 1.25 – 1.29 at 20°C (68°F)
If the specific gravity is less than specification, charge the battery.
Except Maintenance–Free Battery
Z11577
3.
Maintenance–Free Battery Voltmeter
(a)
(b)
Z11556
Maintenance–Free Battery:
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
After having driven the vehicle and in the case that 20
minutes have not passed after having stopped the engine, turn the ignition switch ON and turn on the electrical
system (headlight, blower motor, rear defogger etc.) for
60 seconds to remove the surface charge.
Turn the ignition switch OFF and turn off the electrical systems.
(c)
Measure the battery voltage between the negative (–)
and positive (+) terminals of the battery.
Standard voltage: 12.5 – 12.9 V at 20°C (68°F)
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the battery.
Author:
Date:
1764
CH–2
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
DARK EYE
CHARGED
CHARGING SYSTEM
HINT:
Check the indicator as shown in the illustration.
4.
CHECK BATTERY TERMINALS, FUSIBLE LINK AND
FUSES
(a) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or corroded.
If the terminals are corroded, clean the terminals.
(b) Check the fusible link, H–fuses, M–fuse and fuses for
continuity.
Maintenance–Free Battery
Type A
GREEN EYE
–
CLEAR EYE or
LIGHT YELLOW
DISCHARGED ADD WATER
Type B
Blue
OK
White
Red
Charging Insufficient
Necessary Water
Z18811
5.
(a)
INSPECT DRIVE BELTS
Visually check the drive belt for excessive wear, frayed
cords etc.
If any defect has been found, replace the drive belt.
HINT:
Cracks on the rib side of a drive belt are considered acceptable.
If the drive belt has chunks missing from the ribs, it should be
replaced.
Z00015
DENSO
Borroughs
(b)
Using a belt tension gauge, measure the belt tension.
Belt tension gauge:
DENSO BTG–20 (95506–00020)
Borroughs No. BT–33–73F
Drive belt tension:
New belt
175 ± 5 lbf
Used belt
115 ± 20 lbf
If the belt tension is not as specified, adjust it.
Z00038
HINT:
CORRECT
WRONG
CH0086
”New belt” refers to a belt which has been used less than
5 minutes on a running engine.
”Used belt” refers to a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
After installing a belt, check that it fits properly in the
ribbed grooves.
Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has not
slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the pulley.
Author:
Date:
1765
CH–3
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
CHARGING SYSTEM
After installing a new belt, run the engine for about 5 minutes and recheck the belt tension.
6.
VISUALLY CHECK GENERATOR WIRING AND
LISTEN FOR ABNORMAL NOISES
(a) Check that the wiring is in good condition.
(b) Check that there is no abnormal noise from the generator
while the engine is running.
7.
CHECK DISCHARGE WARNING LIGHT CIRCUIT
(a) Warm up the engine and then turn it off.
(b) Turn off all accessories.
(c) Turn the ignition switch ”ON”. Check that the discharge
warning light is lit.
(d) Start the engine. Check that the light goes off.
If the light does not go off as specified, troubleshoot the discharge light circuit.
Ammeter
Disconnect Wire
from Terminal B
Battery
Voltmeter
Generator
Z03473
8.
INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITHOUT LOAD
HINT:
If a battery/generator tester is available, connect the tester to
the charging circuit as per manufacturer’s instructions.
(a) If a tester is not available, connect a voltmeter and ammeter to the charging circuit as follows:
Disconnect the wire from terminal B of the generator, and connect it to the negative (–) tester probe
of the ammeter.
Connect the positive (+) tester probe of the ammeter to terminal B of the generator.
Connect the positive (+) tester probe of the voltmeter to terminal B of the generator.
Ground the negative (–) tester probe of the voltmeter.
(b) Check the charging circuit as follows:
With the engine running from idling to 2,000 rpm, check
the reading on the ammeter and voltmeter.
Standard amperage: 10 A or less
Standard voltage: 13.5 – 15.1 V
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard voltage, replace
the voltage regulator.
Author:
Date:
1766
CH–4
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
Terminal F
P14228
–
CHARGING SYSTEM
If the voltmeter reading is less than standard voltage, check the
voltage regulator and generator as follows:
With terminal F grounded, start the engine and
check the voltmeter reading of terminal B.
If the voltmeter reading is more than standard voltage, replace the voltage regulator.
If the voltmeter reading is less than standard voltage, check the generator.
9.
INSPECT CHARGING CIRCUIT WITH LOAD
(a) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the high
beam headlights and place the heater blower switch at
”HI”.
(b) Check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 30 A or more
If the ammeter reading is less than the standard amperage, repair the generator.
HINT:
If the battery is fully charged, the indication will sometimes be
less than standard amperage.
Author:
Date:
1767
CH–5
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
GENERATOR
CH01E–01
COMPONENTS
Plate Washer
Generator Wire
Pivot Bolt
Generator Connector
Adjusting Bolt
Generator
Adjusting Lock Bolt
Drive Belt
S05218
Bearing Cover
Front Bearing
Generator Washer
Retainer
Drive End Flame (Stator)
Bearing Cover
Rear Bearing
Pulley
Plate Terminal
Rotor
Terminal Insulator
Rectifire End Flame
Seal Plate
Cord Clip
Rear End Cover
Brush Holder Cover
Brush Holder
Voltage Regulator
Rectifire Holder
Non–reusable part
Robber Insulator x 4
S05077
Author:
Date:
1768
CH–6
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH01F–01
REMOVAL
Pivot Bolt
Adjusting Bolt
Adjusting
Lock Bolt
1.
REMOVE DRIVE BELT
Loosen the pivot bolt, adjusting lock bolt, and adjusting bolt,
and remove the drive belt.
Torque:
Pivot bolt: 56 N·m (570 kgf·cm, 41 ft·lbf)
Lock bolt: 18 N·m (180 kgf·cm, 13 ft·lbf)
P14226
2.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
REMOVE GENERATOR
Disconnect the generator connector.
Remove the nut, and disconnect the generator wire.
Disconnect the wire harness from the clip.
Remove the pivot bolt, plate washer, adjusting lock bolt
and generator.
P14227
Author:
Date:
1769
CH–7
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH01G–01
DISASSEMBLY
Plate Terminal
1.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE REAR END COVER
Remove the nut and terminal insulator.
Remove the screw, 3 nuts, plate terminal and end cover.
2.
(a)
(b)
REMOVE BRUSH HOLDER AND VOLTAGE
REGULATOR
Remove the brush holder cover from the brush holder.
Remove the 5 screws, brush holder and voltage regulator.
3.
(a)
(b)
(c)
REMOVE RECTIFIER HOLDER
Remove the 4 screws and rectifier holder.
Remove the 4 rubber insulators.
Remove the seal plate.
4.
(a)
REMOVE PULLEY
Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST (B)
clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820–63010
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Check that SST (A) is secured to the rotor shaft.
P14233
P14234
S05072
Turn
SST (A)
(b)
SST (B)
P10835
(c)
(d)
Mount SST (C) in a vise.
Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley nut to
SST (C).
SST (B)
SST (C)
Insert
P10834
Author:
Date:
1770
CH–8
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
(e)
SST (C)
SST (A)
Turn
To loosen the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
To prevent damage to the rotor shaft, do not
loosen the pulley nut more than one–half of a turn.
(f)
Remove the generator from SST (C).
P10827
Turn
(g)
(h)
Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
Remove the pulley nut and pulley.
5.
(a)
REMOVE RECTIFIER END FRAME
Remove the 4 nuts and cord clip.
(b)
Using SST, remove the rectifier end frame.
SST 09286–46011
Remove the generator washer.
REMOVE ROTOR FROM DRIVE END FRAME
SST (A)
SST (B)
P10836
S05073
(c)
6.
SST
P01762
Author:
Date:
1771
CH–9
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH01H–01
INSPECTION
1.
(a)
INSPECT ROTOR
Check the rotor for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the slip rings.
Standard resistance: 2.1 – 2.5 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If there is no continuity, replace the rotor.
Ohmmeter
Continuity
CH0784
(b)
Check the rotor for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the slip ring and rotor.
If there is continuity, replace the rotor.
Ohmmeter
No Continuity
CH0783
(c) Check that the slip rings are not rough or scored.
If rough or scored, replace the rotor.
(d) Using vernier calipers, measure the slip ring diameter.
Standard diameter: 14.2 – 14.4 mm (0.559–0.567 in.)
Minimum diameter: 12.8 mm (0.504 in.)
If the diameter is less than minimum, replace the rotor.
CH0192
2.
(a)
INSPECT STATOR (DRIVE END FRAME)
Check the stator for open circuit.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the coil leads.
If there is no continuity, replace the drive end frame assembly.
Continuity
Ohmmeter
P00484
(b)
Check the stator for ground.
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the coil lead and drive end frame.
If there is continuity, replace the drive end frame assembly.
Continuity
Ohmmeter
P00482
Author:
Date:
1772
CH–10
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
3.
INSPECT BRUSHES
Using a vernier caliper, measure the exposed brush length.
Standard exposed length: 10.5 mm (0.413 in.)
Minimum exposed length: 1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
If the exposed length is less than minimum, replace the brushes
and brush holder assembly.
Length
P13535
4.
(a)
Ohmmeter
Positive (+)
Terminal
Rectifire
Terminal
P00480
Negative (–)
Treminal
Ohmmeter
P00481
INSPECT RECTIFIERS (RECTIFIRE HOLDER)
Check the positive (+) rectifire.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, connect one tester probe to the
positive (+) terminal and the other to each rectifier
terminal.
(2) Reverse the polarity of the tester probes and repeat
step (a).
(3) Check that one shows continuity and the other
shows no continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the rectifier holder.
(b) Check the negative (–) rectifire.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, connect one tester probe to
each negative (–) terminal and the other to each
rectifier terminal.
(2) Reverse the polarity of the tester probes and repeat
step (a).
(3) Check that one shows continuity and the other
shows no continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the rectifier holder.
5.
INSPECT BEARING
Check the bearing is not rough or worn.
If necessary, replace the bearing. (See page CH–11)
Author:
Date:
1773
CH–11
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH01I–01
REPLACEMENT
1.
(a)
REPLACE FRONT BEARING
Remove the 4 screws, bearing retainer and bearing.
(b)
Using a socket wrench and press, press out the bearing.
(c)
Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09950–60010 (09951–00500)
Install the bearing retainer with the 4 screws.
Torque: 3.0 N·m (31 kgf·cm, 27 in.·lbf)
P14225
Socket Wrench
P00628
SST
(d)
P00479
2.
(a)
REPLACE REAR BEARING
Using SST, remove the bearing cover (outside) and bearing.
SST 09820–00021
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the fan.
(b) Remove the bearing cover (inside).
SST
N00581
(c)
Place the bearing cover (inside) on the rotor.
P13567
Author:
Date:
1774
CH–12
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
(d)
Using SST and a press, press in a new bearing.
SST 09820–00030
(e)
Using SST, push in the bearing cover (outside).
SST 09285–76010
SST
N00578
SST
P00074
Author:
Date:
1775
CH–13
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH01J–01
REASSEMBLY
Pulley
1.
(a)
(b)
INSTALL ROTOR TO DRIVE END FRAME
Place the rectifier end frame on the pulley.
Install the rotor to the rectifier end frame.
2.
(a)
INSTALL RECTIFIER END FRAME
Place the generator washer on the rotor.
(b)
Using a 29 mm socket wrench and press, slowly press in
the rectifier end frame.
(c)
Install the cord clip with the 4 nuts.
Torque:
Nut A: 4.5 N·m (46 kgf·cm, 40 in.·lbf)
Nut B: 5.4 N·m (55 kgf·cm, 48 in.·lbf)
3.
(a)
INSTALL PULLEY
Install the pulley to the rotor shaft by tightening the pulley
nut by hand.
Hold SST (A) with a torque wrench, and tighten SST (B)
clockwise to the specified torque.
SST 09820–63010
Torque: 39 N·m (400 kgf·cm, 29 ft·lbf)
Check that SST (A) is secured to the pulley shaft.
P01364
P00427
29 mm
Socket
Wrench
P01763
A
B
A
A
Z19214
Turn
(b)
SST (A)
(c)
SST (B)
P10835
Author:
Date:
1776
CH–14
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
(d)
(e)
Mount SST (C) in a vise.
Insert SST (B) into SST (C), and attach the pulley nut to
SST (C).
(f)
(g)
To torque the pulley nut, turn SST (A) in the direction
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 110.5 N·m (1,125 kgf·cm, 81 ft·lbf)
Remove the generator from SST (C).
(h)
Turn SST (B), and remove SST (A and B).
4.
(a)
INSTALL RECTIFIER HOLDER
Place the seal plate on the rectifier end frame.
(b)
Install the 4 rubber insulators on the lead wires.
SST (A)
SST (C)
Insert
P10834
SST (C)
SST (A)
Turn
P10829
Turn
SST (A)
SST (B)
P10836
P00428
P00645
Author:
Date:
1777
CH–15
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
(c)
–
GENERATOR
Install the rectifier holder with the 4 screws.
Torque: 2.9 N·m (30 kgf·cm, 26 in.·lbf)
S05072
5.
Upward
INSTALL VOLTAGE REGULATOR AND BRUSH
HOLDER
(a) Place the voltage regulator and brush holder on the rectifier end frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the holder installation direction.
(b) Install the 5 screws.
Torque: 2.0 N·m (20 kgf·cm, 18 in.·lbf)
S05460
(c)
Place the brush holder cover on the brush holder.
6.
(a)
INSTALL REAR END COVER
Install the end cover and plate terminal with the 3 nuts and
screw.
Torque:
Screw: 3.9 N·m (39 kgf·cm, 35 in.·lbf)
Nut: 4.4 N·m (45 kgf·cm, 39 in.·lbf)
(b)
Install the terminal insulator with the nut.
Torque: 4.1 N·m (42 kgf·cm, 36 in.·lbf)
CHECK THAT ROTOR ROTATES SMOOTHLY
P14235
Plate Terminal
P14233
7.
S05071
Author:
Date:
1778
CH–16
CHARGING (1MZ–FE)
–
GENERATOR
CH01K–01
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. (See page ST–5)
Author:
Date:
1779